Official Software
Get notified when we add a new ChevroletTrailblazer Manual

We cover 60 Chevrolet vehicles, were you looking for one of these?

Chevrolet Aveo 2007-2010 Factory Repair Manual PDF
Chevrolet Suburban 2000-2006 FACTORY Service Repair Manual PDF
Malibu L4-2.4L (2010)
Chevrolet Cruze Workshop Manual (L4-1.4L Turbo (2011))
Silverado 1500 4WD V8-4.8L VIN V (2004)
Chevrolet Impala Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2008))
Chevrolet Blazer 4wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2005))
Chevrolet Silverado 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-6.0L VIN U (2004))
Silverado 1500 4WD V8-5.3L VIN T (2004)
Chevrolet Equinox Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.4L VIN F (2006))
Chevrolet Traverse Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.6L (2011))
Chevrolet Silverado, GMC Full Size Trucks Chilton Repair Manual
Chevrolet Impala Workshop Manual (V6-3.8L VIN K (2004))
Chevrolet Malibu Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L VIN 8 (2004))
Chevrolet - Epica - Workshop Manual - 2008 - 2008
Chevrolet - Malibu - Workshop Manual - 2007 - 2009
Chevrolet - S-10 - Workshop Manual - (2001)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet - Tahoe - Workshop Manual - 2001 - 2002
Chevrolet - Spark - Workshop Manual - 2011 - 2011
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 L4-134 2.2L (1991))
Chevrolet Avalanche 1500 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.3L VIN T (2003))
Chevrolet Express 4500 Workshop Manual (V8-6.0L (2010))
Chevrolet Camaro Workshop Manual (V8-350 5.7L (1989))
Chevrolet Astro Van Awd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2003))
Chevrolet Caprice Workshop Manual (V8-305 5.0L VIN E TBI (1991))
Chevrolet Silverado 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-6.6L DSL Turbo VIN 2 (2004))
Chevrolet Silverado 1500 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.3L VIN Z Flex Fuel (2005))
Chevrolet Equinox Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.4L (2008))
Chevrolet Chevette Workshop Manual (L4-98 1.6L (1982))
Chevrolet Colorado 2wd Workshop Manual (L4-2.8L VIN 8 (2004))
Uplander FWD V6-3.5L VIN L (2006)
Chevrolet - Monte Carlo - Workshop Manual - (2004)
Chevrolet Equinox Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.4L VIN F (2005))
Chevrolet - Cruze - Workshop Manual - 2011 - 2015
Chevrolet Silverado 1500 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-4.8L VIN V (2006))
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Camaro Workshop Manual (V8-6.2L (2010))
2010 Chevrolet Cruze Body Repair Manual
Chevrolet K Tahoe 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.7L VIN R (1996))
Chevrolet Silverado 1500 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.3L VIN T (2004))
Tahoe 4WD V8-5.3L VIN T (2004)
Chevrolet Chevelle Workshop Manual (Chevelle-Malibu V8-305 5.0L (1983))
Chevrolet G 30 Van Workshop Manual (V8-379 6.2L DSL (1987))
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (L4-2.2L VIN F (2004))
Chevrolet Silverado Classic 1500 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-6.0L (2007))
2001-2005--Chevrolet--Impala--6 Cylinders K 3.8L FI OHV--32849802
Chevrolet K 1500 Suburban 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-454 7.4L VIN N TBI (1995))
Chevrolet Equinox Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.0L (2010))
Chevrolet Express 1500 Awd Workshop Manual (V8-5.3L (2008))
Chevrolet - Express - Wiring Diagram - 2019 - 2019
Chevrolet Caprice Classic Workshop Manual (V8-305 5.0L VIN E TBI (1991))
Chevrolet Malibu Workshop Manual (V6-191 3.1L VIN M SFI (1997))
Silverado 1500 2WD V6-4.3L (2007)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN W CPI (1992))
Malibu L4-2.2L VIN F (2005)
Chevrolet Hhr Workshop Manual (L4-2.2L (2007))
Chevrolet Silverado 1500 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2004))
Chevrolet Impala Workshop Manual (V6-3.4L VIN E (2000))
Lumina V6-204 3.4L DOHC VIN X SFI (1996)
Summary of Content
Page 852 pulling it through. This will prevent damage to the internal seals of the connector. Once the terminal is pushed out of the connector, cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible and pull the wire through the connector. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE The Micro-Pack 100W connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool was developed to crimp Micro-Pack 100W terminals. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 2. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert the terminal into the crimp tool until the core wings are flush with the anvil on the crimp tool. Be sure that the wings are pointed toward the crimp tool former and release the spring locator. The locator will hold the terminal in place. Inspect the alignment of the terminal wings with the crimp tool former. If the terminal wings are wider than the crimp tool former, remove the terminal and bend the terminal wings in slightly. 5. Place stripped wire into terminal. 6. Crimp the new terminal to the wire. If a jam occurs, press the emergency release to open applicator. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire perform the following procedure in order to replace Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. Page 6573 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Kostal Connectors KOSTAL CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 432 breakers are used. CIRCUIT BREAKER This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high current is removed. POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) CIRCUIT BREAKER This type greatly increases its resistance when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker will re-close within a second or 2. Circuit Protection - Fuses CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSES The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and examine the element in the fuse for an open (2). If not broken (1), also check for continuity using a DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one of equal current rating. Circuit Protection - Fusible Links CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSIBLE LINKS Page 8202 The engine harness may be repaired using the J-38125. High Temperature Wiring Repairs HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperatures, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time may use materials i.e. wires, connectors, and shielding that has a higher heat rating than typical wiring. When making a repair in a high temperature area observe the following: Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature to replace any damaged wire. - Replace any heat shielding that is removed. - Cover any DuraSeal splice sleeves with SCT1 shrink tubing (available in the J-38125 Terminal Repair kit). - After making a wiring repair, ensure that the location of the wiring is not moved closer to the heat source. IDENTIFYING HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperature, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time need special considerations when making wiring repairs. Areas that may be exposed to higher temperatures can be identified by heat resistant materials that are being used in those areas. These materials may include heat reflective tape, moon tape, and high temperature shrink tubing. Also conduit and other protective coverings may be used. Because conduit or similar coverings are used throughout the vehicle regardless of the temperature, it may be necessary for the technician to determine if an area is exposed to excessive heat before making a wiring repair. Obvious areas of consideration would be any area located near the exhaust manifolds, catalytic converter, and exhaust pipes. The J-38125 contains much of the material you will need to perform repairs on areas exposed to high heat. The kit contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves to crimp and seal connections - High temperature SCT1 shrink tubing to protect the splice sleeves - A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct crimp tool to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools to remove the terminals from the connectors The J-38125 does not contain wire that is suitable to high temperature exposure. Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature of the same or larger gage size as the original wire when repair damage wire. Also replace any reflective tape that you remove during the repair. HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature rating of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125 and then encapsulate the splice sleeve using the high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the order listed. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip keeping all of the wire strands intact. Page 4476 vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide variety of actions, including: - Wiggling the harness - Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting - Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector - Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation - Relocating a harness or wires All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. Another option is, with the component commanded ON and OFF by the scan tool, move related connectors and wiring and observe the component operation. With the engine running, move related connectors and wiring while monitoring engine operation. If harness or connector movement affects the data displayed, component/system operation, or engine operation, inspect and repair the harness/connections as necessary. You may need to load the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these cases you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide good results as well. There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions, along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the circuit to these kinds of conditions. SALT WATER SPRAY Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture. Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5 percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously. HIGH TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070. Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault condition. The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis. This option does not allow for the same control, however. LOW TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect. If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to -18°C (0°F) from one end and +71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized cooling needs. Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or components in an effort to duplicate the concern. DUPLICATING FAILURE CONDITIONS - If none of the previous tests are successful, attempt to duplicate and/or capture the failure conditions. Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, where applicable, contains the conditions that were present when the DTC set. 1. Review and record Freeze Frame/Failure Records data. 2. Clear the DTCs using the scan tool. 3. Turn the key to OFF and wait 15 seconds. 4. Operate the vehicle under the same conditions that were noted in Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, as closely as possible. The vehicle must also be operating within the Conditions for Running the DTC. Refer to Conditions for Running the DTC in the supporting text if a DTC is being diagnosed. 5. Monitor DTC Status for the DTC being tested. The scan tool will indicate Ran, when the enabling conditions have been satisfied long enough for the DTC to run. The scan tool will also indicate whether the DTC passed or failed. - An alternate method is to drive the vehicle with the DMM connected to a suspected circuit. An abnormal reading on the DMM when the concern occurs, may help you locate the concern. Measuring Frequency Page 7870 Body Control Module: Diagrams Body Control Module (BCM) C3 Body Control Module (BCM) C3 Page 2488 7. Pressing the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool in the release cavity of the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and crimper in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (DOOR MODULE) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Side view of connector. View of top of connector. 1. Locate the assist lever and lock on the top of the connector. Page 8163 Release the lower wiredress cover locking tab. Release the upper wiredress cover locking tab. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. Page 7380 MOLEX CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. 2. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. Page 8415 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) and slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. Page 4443 Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size. REPAIRING A FUSIBLE LINK IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient overload protection. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. Flat Wire Repairs FLAT WIRE REPAIRS NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced. GMLAN Wiring Repairs GMLAN WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The GM Local Area Network (GMLAN) System requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working on GMLAN connectors and terminals. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items in order to repair the GMLAN wiring: Dura Seal splice sleeves - A wire stripping tool - J 38125-8 Crimping Tool (GM P/N 12085115) - J 38125-5 Ultra Torch Special Tool (GM P/N 12085116) The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. - A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors GMLAN REPAIRS IMPORTANT: When making a repair to any GMLAN network, the original wire length after the repair must be the same length as before the repair. If the network is a twisted pair, the twist must be maintained after the repair is completed. GMLAN has 2 types of networks, low speed and high speed. Low speed GMLAN has a single wire and works at slow speeds. High speed GMLAN has 2 wires in a twisted pair and works at higher speeds. For more information on GMLAN, refer to Data Link Communications Description and Operation. GMLAN CONNECTOR TERMINAL REPAIR IMPORTANT: A service terminal can be used to replace damaged connector terminals for both high speed and low speed GMLAN systems. When making a connector terminal repair on a GMLAN high speed system with twisted pair wires, do not untwist the wires more than necessary to make the repair. The terminals in the GMLAN system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are available in the J-38125. If the individual terminals are damaged on any GMLAN connection, use the appropriate connector repair procedure in order to repair the terminal. GMLAN WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 3431 The engine harness may be repaired using the J-38125. High Temperature Wiring Repairs HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperatures, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time may use materials i.e. wires, connectors, and shielding that has a higher heat rating than typical wiring. When making a repair in a high temperature area observe the following: Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature to replace any damaged wire. - Replace any heat shielding that is removed. - Cover any DuraSeal splice sleeves with SCT1 shrink tubing (available in the J-38125 Terminal Repair kit). - After making a wiring repair, ensure that the location of the wiring is not moved closer to the heat source. IDENTIFYING HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperature, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time need special considerations when making wiring repairs. Areas that may be exposed to higher temperatures can be identified by heat resistant materials that are being used in those areas. These materials may include heat reflective tape, moon tape, and high temperature shrink tubing. Also conduit and other protective coverings may be used. Because conduit or similar coverings are used throughout the vehicle regardless of the temperature, it may be necessary for the technician to determine if an area is exposed to excessive heat before making a wiring repair. Obvious areas of consideration would be any area located near the exhaust manifolds, catalytic converter, and exhaust pipes. The J-38125 contains much of the material you will need to perform repairs on areas exposed to high heat. The kit contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves to crimp and seal connections - High temperature SCT1 shrink tubing to protect the splice sleeves - A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct crimp tool to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools to remove the terminals from the connectors The J-38125 does not contain wire that is suitable to high temperature exposure. Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature of the same or larger gage size as the original wire when repair damage wire. Also replace any reflective tape that you remove during the repair. HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature rating of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125 and then encapsulate the splice sleeve using the high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the order listed. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip keeping all of the wire strands intact. Page 5402 Page 727 2. Locate the two indents of the terminal position assurance (TPA) located on the bottom of the connector body. Page 5728 4. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the rear of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. 5. Once the locking tabs are unlocked, slide the inner connector out of the rear of the connector housing. Page 2359 2. Locate the two indents of the terminal position assurance (TPA) located on the bottom of the connector body. Page 4581 All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system. Page 8180 3. Remove the dress cover by using a flat-blade tool to release the connector locking tabs and pulling off the dress cover. 4. Relieve the tension on the nose piece retainers by inserting J-38125-12A (12094429) into the single retainer slot on the end of the nose piece and gently prying out the locking tab. Repeat the process for both of the nose piece locking tabs on the opposite side of the nose piece. Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON Air Filter Element: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-013B Date: February 01, 2007 INFORMATION Subject: Automatic Transmission Shift, Engine Driveability Concerns or Service Engine Soon (SES) Light On as a Result of the Use of an Excessively/Over-Oiled Aftermarket, Reusable Air Filter Models: 2007 and Prior GM Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2007 and Prior Saturn Models 2003-2007 HUMMER H2 2006-2007 HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 04-07-30-013A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle). The use of an excessively/over-oiled aftermarket, reusable air filter may result in: Service Engine Soon (SES) light on Transmission shift concerns, slipping and damaged clutch(es) or band(s) Engine driveability concerns, poor acceleration from a stop, limited engine RPM range The oil that is used on these air filter elements may be transferred onto the Mass Air Flow (MAF) sensor causing contamination of the sensor. As a result, the Grams per Second (GPS) signal from the MAF may be low and any or all of the concerns listed above may occur. When servicing a vehicle with any of these concerns, be sure to check for the presence of an aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter. The MAF, GPS reading should be compared to a like vehicle with an OEM air box and filter under the same driving conditions to verify the concern. The use of an aftermarket reusable air filter DOES NOT void the vehicle's warranty. If an aftermarket reusable air filter is used, technicians should inspect the MAF sensor element and the air induction hose for contamination of oil prior to making warranty repairs. Transmission or engine driveability concerns (related to the MAF sensor being contaminated with oil) that are the result of the use of an aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter are not considered to be warrantable repair items. Page 4029 3. Install the engine mount to engine. Tighten the engine mount bolts to 50 N.m (37 lb ft). 4. Install the engine mount frame bracket to the frame. 5. Install the engine mount frame bracket retaining bolts. Tighten the bolts to 100 N.m (74 lb ft). 6. Shift engine back to the right side of the frame. 7. Install the left side engine mount frame bracket. 8. Install the retaining bolts to the left side of the engine mount frame bracket. Tighten the bolts to 100 N.m (74 lb ft). 9. Lower the engine, aligning the engine mount studs with the holes in the frame bracket. 10. Remove the pole jack and the block of wood. Page 5040 Important: Do not apply sealant to the first 3 threads of the bolt. 1. Apply a 5 mm (0.2 in) wide band of threadlock GM P/N 12345493, (Canadian P/N 10953488), or equivalent to the threads of the exhaust manifold bolts. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Install the exhaust manifold NEW gasket and bolts. 1. Tighten the bolts a first pass to 15 N.m (11 lb ft). Tighten the bolts beginning with the center 2 bolts. Alternate from side-to-side, and work toward the outside bolts. 2. Tighten the bolts a final pass to 25 N.m (18 lb ft). Tighten the bolts beginning with the center 2 bolts. Alternate from side-to-side, and work toward the outside bolts. 3. Install the heat shield, and bolts to the exhaust manifold. Tighten the bolts to 9 N.m (80 lb in). 4. Using a flat punch, bend over the exposed edge of the exhaust manifold gasket at the rear of the left cylinder head. 5. Install the spark plugs. Refer to Spark Plug Replacement for the 5.3L engine or Spark Plug Replacement for the 6.0L engine. 6. Raise the vehicle. 7. Install the nuts that secure the catalytic converter to the left exhaust manifold. Tighten the nuts to 50 N.m (37 lb ft). 8. Lower the vehicle. Page 7611 It is very important to use the correct test adapter when testing for proper terminal contact of fuses and relays in a bussed electrical center (BEC). Use J-35616-35 to test for proper terminal contact. Failure to use J-35616-35 can result in improper diagnosis of the BEC. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Separate the connector halves. 2. Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body. 3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J-38125 , test that the retention force is significantly different between a good terminal and a suspect terminal. Replace the female terminal in question. FLAT WIRE (DOCK AND LOCK) CONNECTORS There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock) connectors on the harness side or the component side. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Remove the component in question. 2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side of the connector as oil from your skin may be a source of contamination as well. 3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other imperfections that could cause poor terminal contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are uniform and free of damage or deformation. 4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the on the flat wire harness connector in order to test the circuit in question. CONTROL MODULE/COMPONENT VOLTAGE AND GROUNDS Poor voltage or ground connections can cause widely varying symptoms. Test all control module voltage supply circuits. Many vehicles have multiple circuits supplying voltage to a control module. Other components in the system may have separate voltage supply circuits that may also need to be tested. Inspect connections at the module/component connectors, fuses, and any intermediate connections between the voltage source and the module/component. A test lamp or a DMM may indicate that voltage is present, but neither tests the ability of the circuit to carry sufficient current. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Power Distribution Schematics. - Test all control module ground and system ground circuits. The control module may have multiple ground circuits. Other components in the system may have separate grounds that may also need to be tested. Inspect grounds for clean and tight connections at the grounding point. Inspect the connections at the component and in splice packs, where applicable. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Ground Distribution Schematics. TEMPERATURE SENSITIVITY - An intermittent condition may occur when a component/connection reaches normal operating temperature. The condition may occur only when the component/connection is cold, or only when the component/connection is hot. - Freeze Frame, Failure Records, Snapshot, or Vehicle Data Recorder data may help with this type of intermittent condition, where applicable. - If the intermittent is related to heat, review the data for a relationship with the following: High ambient temperatures - Underhood/engine generated heat - Circuit generated heat due to a poor connection, or high electrical load - Higher than normal load conditions, towing, etc. - If the intermittent is related to cold, review the data for the following: Low ambient temperatures-In extremely low temperatures, ice may form in a connection or component. Inspect for water intrusion. - The condition only occurs on a cold start. - The condition goes away when the vehicle warms up. - Information from the customer may help to determine if the trouble follows a pattern that is temperature related. - If temperature is suspected of causing an intermittent fault condition, attempt to duplicate the condition. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required. ELECTROMAGNETIC INTERFERENCE (EMI) AND ELECTRICAL NOISE Some electrical components/circuits are sensitive to electromagnetic interference (EMI) or other types of electrical noise. Inspect for the following conditions: A misrouted harness that is too close to high voltage/high current devices such as secondary ignition components, motors, generator etc-These components may induce electrical noise on a circuit that could interfere with normal circuit operation. - Electrical system interference caused by a malfunctioning relay, or a control module driven solenoid or switch-These conditions can cause a sharp electrical surge. Normally, the condition will occur when the malfunctioning component is operating. - Improper installation of non-factory or aftermarket add on accessories such as lights, 2-way radios, amplifiers, electric motors, remote starters, alarm systems, cell phones, etc-These accessories may lead to interference while in use, but do not fail when the accessories are not in use. - Test for an open diode across the A/C compressor clutch and for other open diodes. Some relays may contain a clamping diode. - The generator may be allowing AC noise into the electrical system. INCORRECT CONTROL MODULE - There are only a few situations where reprogramming a control module is appropriate: A new service control module is installed. Page 1102 Wheel Speed Sensor: Diagrams Antilock Brake System Connector End Views Wheel Speed Sensor - LF Wheel Speed Sensor - LF Wheel Speed Sensor - LR Page 8842 6. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by pressing on the tang. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (SENSOR) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) tool into the cavity on the lower right hand face of the connector until the terminal release tang access panel slides over. Page 850 2. Locate the nose piece locking tabs that are positioned on the side of the connector nose piece. The connector nose piece acts as a terminal positive assurance (TPA) and may be referred to as such. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to push in one of the locking tabs while gently pulling on the same side of the nose piece. 4. Repeat the procedure for the other locking tab and remove the nose piece. 5. Remove the wire dress cover. The following is a general procedure for wire dress cover removal. Use this procedure as a guide, some dress cover removal procedures may vary. 6. Use fingers to squeeze the 2 locking legs of the cover. Page 1987 Connector Anatomy Connector Repairs contains a list of all connector repairs. The connector repairs are listed by the connector manufacturer and then by connector type. If the technician cannot identify the manufacturer of the connector, refer to Identifying Connectors below. Knowing the connector manufacturer will assist in finding the correct connector repair from the following list: - Connector Position Assurance Locks - Terminal Position Assurance Locks - Bosch Connectors (0.64) Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) Bosch Connectors (BSK) Bosch Connectors (ECM) - Delphi Connectors (Micro.64) Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) Delphi Connectors (12-Way) - Tyco/AMP Connectors (CM 42-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) Tyco/AMP Connectors (025 Cap) Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) - Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) - Repairing Connector Terminals IDENTIFYING CONNECTORS Knowing the connector manufacturer is helpful when trying to locating the correct connector repair procedure. There are many different connector designs used on GM vehicles and it is sometimes difficult to identify the connector manufacturer. The information in this document should help with the identification of connector manufactures. The following connector manufacturers make most of the connectors found in GM vehicles: AFL/EPC (Alcoa Fujikura Ltd./Engineered Plastics Components) - Bosch - Delphi - FCI (Framatome Connectors International) - JAE (Japan Aviation Electronics) - JST (Japan Solderless Terminals) Page 5611 11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the solder equipment. 12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. 13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to cover the first piece of tape. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE SLEEVES TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit IMPORTANT: Use only dura seal splice sleeves. Other splice sleeves may not protect the splice from moisture or provide a good electrical connection. Use duraseal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. Use duraseal splice sleeves where there is special requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire using duraseal splice sleeves. Page 4398 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert terminal into the appropriate terminal holder until it hits bottom and stops. The correct terminal holder is determined by the wire size. Also ensure that the terminals wings are pointing towards the former on the tool and the release locator. 5. Insert the stripped cable into the terminal. Insulation should be visible on both sides of the terminal insulation wings. 6. Compress the handles until the ratchet automatically releases. 7. Place the terminal into the appropriate cavity and assemble the connector. Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO-PACK 100W) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W connectors. These connectors are very similar but use different terminals and have some minor physical differences also. Page 7392 4. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the rear of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. 5. Once the locking tabs are unlocked, slide the inner connector out of the rear of the connector housing. Page 4579 Page 5747 If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the DuraSeal splice sleeves. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: - Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. - Do not use the crimp and DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 to crimp DuraSeal splice sleeve. In order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 2772 4. Install one bolt (M6 X 1.0 X 47.5) hand tight in the center (1) of the valve body to hold it in place. Important: When installing bolts throughout this procedure, be sure to use the correct bolt size and length in the correct location as specified. 5. Do not install the transmission fluid indicator stop bracket and bolt at this time. Install but do not tighten the control valve body bolts which retain only the valve body directly. Each numbered bolt location corresponds to a specific bolt size and length, as indicated by the following: ^ M6 X 1.0 X 65.0 (1) ^ M6 X 1.0 X 54.4 (2) ^ M6 X 1.0 X 47.5 (3) ^ M6 X 1.0 X 35.0 (4) ^ M8 X 1.0 X 20.0 (5) ^ M6 X 1.0 X 12.0 (6) ^ M6 X 1.0 X 18.0 (7) 6. Install the manual detent spring. 7. Install but do not tighten the manual detent spring retaining bolt. Page 2344 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert terminal into the appropriate terminal holder until it hits bottom and stops. The correct terminal holder is determined by the wire size. Also ensure that the terminals wings are pointing towards the former on the tool and the release locator. 5. Insert the stripped cable into the terminal. Insulation should be visible on both sides of the terminal insulation wings. 6. Compress the handles until the ratchet automatically releases. 7. Place the terminal into the appropriate cavity and assemble the connector. Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO-PACK 100W) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W connectors. These connectors are very similar but use different terminals and have some minor physical differences also. Page 4139 Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 6. Install the 2 lower bellhousing bolts. 1. Tighten the lower bellhousing bolts to 50 N.m (37 lb ft). 2. Tighten the 2 rear oil pan to rear cover bolts to 12 N.m (106 lb in). 3. Tighten the remaining oil pan bolts to 25 N.m (18 lb ft). 7. Install the 2 lower A/C compressor bracket bolts (3). Tighten the bolts to 50 N.m (37 lb ft). 8. Tighten the 2 upper A/C compressor bracket bolts (4). Tighten the bolts to 50 N.m (37 lb ft). Page 223 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. JST Connectors JST CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, remove the connector from the component. Page 1342 4. Once the front 2 locks are unlocked, lift the front of the dress cover and pull it forward. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the small slot on the TPA and pushing down until the TPA releases. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to angle or rock the J 38125-21 tool when inserting it into the connector or the tool may break. Insert the J 38125-21 (GM P/N 15381651-2) tool into the round canal between the terminals cavities at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to repair Micro 64 connector terminals. The Micro 64 connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-64 (M jaw) was developed to crimp Micro 64 terminals. The J 38125-64 crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. The J 38125-64 crimping tool is also designed to crimp both the wire and the insulation at the same time. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro 64 terminals. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. 1. Cut the wire as close to the damaged terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. Page 8501 Locations Central Control Module: Locations Entertainment/Communication Component Views Vehicle Communication Interface Module (VCIM) 1 - Connectors 2 - Body Harness 3 - Rear Floor Panel 4 - Vehicle Communication Interface Module (VCIM) Page 487 5. Insert the J 38125-557 (GM P/N 12122378) into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 6. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Connector Position Assurance Locks CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of the connector. CPAs are used in various connectors throughout the vehicle. CPAs are also used in all SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals, of the connector. Connector Repairs CONNECTOR REPAIRS Page 2461 pulling it through. This will prevent damage to the internal seals of the connector. Once the terminal is pushed out of the connector, cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible and pull the wire through the connector. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE The Micro-Pack 100W connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool was developed to crimp Micro-Pack 100W terminals. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 2. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert the terminal into the crimp tool until the core wings are flush with the anvil on the crimp tool. Be sure that the wings are pointed toward the crimp tool former and release the spring locator. The locator will hold the terminal in place. Inspect the alignment of the terminal wings with the crimp tool former. If the terminal wings are wider than the crimp tool former, remove the terminal and bend the terminal wings in slightly. 5. Place stripped wire into terminal. 6. Crimp the new terminal to the wire. If a jam occurs, press the emergency release to open applicator. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire perform the following procedure in order to replace Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. Page 6603 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Start in the middle and gradually move the heat barrel to the open ends of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Heated Oxygen Sensor Wiring Repairs HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being obstructed. If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. - Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks, etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire. - Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance. - To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector. Page 2007 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the TPA. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the nose piece. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. Page 3432 Open the harness by removing any tape. 2. Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. 3. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 4. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent american wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 5. Slide a section of high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing down the length of wire to be spliced. Ensure that the shrink tubing will not interfere with the splice procedure. 6. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 7. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. 8. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 9. Insert the wire into the DuraSeal splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 10. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Page 4123 6. Lower the vehicle. 7. Fill the crankcase with the proper quantity and grade of engine oil. Refer to Approximate Fluid Capacities and to Fluid and Lubricant Recommendations. 8. Remove the oil level indicator. 9. Wipe the indicator with a clean cloth. 10. Install the oil level indicator. 11. Remove the oil level indicator in order to check the level. 12. Add oil if necessary. 13. Close the hood. Page 2664 1 - Seat Belt Switch Connector - Passenger 2 - Inflatable Restraint Front Passenger Presence System (PPS) Sensor 3 - Inflatable Restraint Front Passenger Presence System (PPS) Module 4 Heated Seat Element Connector - Passenger Cushion (w/Heat) Rollover Sensor Page 515 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Kostal Connectors KOSTAL CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 5461 4. Slide the dress cover forward and off of the connector. 5. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front and rear of the connector. Page 1129 20. Extract a portion of the ECT sensor harness wiring and connector from the protective conduit. Cut off the ECT sensor harness connector and wiring. 21. Determine a routing path for the ECT sensor jumper harness wires so that they can be secured TO or WITHIN an existing protective conduit. Note This step is to set up and verify the length of wiring that is required before cutting. 22. Route the ECT sensor jumper wires and then enclose them in their own protective conduit in order to VERIFY the length that is required. 23. Cut the ECT sensor jumper wires to the appropriate length. Note Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splice or connector. 24. Splice the ECT sensor jumper wires to the ORIGINAL ECT HARNESS LOCATION using DuraSeal weatherproof splices. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves in SI. Note Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splice or connector. 25. Splice the ECT sensor jumper wires to the ECT SENSOR HARNESS CONNECTOR using DuraSeal weatherproof splices. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves in SI. 26. Connect the ECT sensor harness connector to the ECT sensor. 27. Secure the ECT sensor jumper wires that are in their own protective conduit TO or WITHIN the existing harness conduit using tie straps. Important You MUST run the engine at the specified RPM and until it reaches normal operating temperature and then allow it to idle as indicated in SI. The engine MUST then be allowed to cool down in order to top off the coolant level as needed. 28. Fill the cooling system to the proper level. Refer to Cooling System Draining and Filling in SI. 29. Pressure test the cooling system. Refer to Cooling System Leak Testing in SI. 30. Use a scan tool to clear any DTCs. Relocating the Engine Coolant Heater Cord Important For reference, the procedure and graphics that are shown are from a Chevrolet Silverado, but are similar for the other vehicles listed above. 1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Ask the customer where they would prefer the extension cord to exit from the engine compartment in order to determine the required extension cord length. 3. Obtain an extension cord with the following features: - 120 volt - 14/3 gauge - 15A capacity - Three prong - Polarized plug and receptacle - Chemical resistant - Grounded terminals - Designed for use in a cold outdoor environment - Outer jacket resistant to deterioration from moisture, abrasion and exposure to sunlight - Maximum length of 2.5-3 m (8-10 ft) 4. Release enough of the clips that retain the engine coolant heater cord to the vehicle to provide the necessary length for repositioning. 5. Apply dielectric grease to the electrical contacts of the heater cord receptacle and the extension cord plug to prevent corrosion. Use GM P/N 12345579 (in Canada, use P/N 10953481) or an equivalent. 6. Connect the heater cord receptacle to the extension cord plug and wipe OFF any excess grease. Page 7221 View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. View of the release tool being used for the smaller terminals. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (2-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 6102 TERMINAL REMOVAL Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors. 1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA) device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1). 3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 4. Gently pull the cable and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector. 5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal, refer to Terminal Repair. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3. Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector. REINSTALLING TERMINAL 1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly, refer to Wiring Repairs. 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3. Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) DELPHI CONNECTORS (WEATHER PACK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 6567 Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. FCI Connectors FCI CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 1973 - A control module from another vehicle is installed. - Revised software/calibration files have been released for this vehicle. - IMPORTANT: DO NOT re-program the control module with the SAME software/calibration files that are already present in the control module. This is not an effective repair for any type of concern. Verify that the control module contains the correct software/calibration. If incorrect programming is found, reprogram the control module with the most current software/calibration. Refer to Control Module References for replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Testing for Short to Ground TESTING FOR SHORT TO GROUND NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 4. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit. With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is a short to ground in the circuit. Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2. Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). - When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. - If the DMM does not display voltage 4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is shorted. Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A DIGITAL MULTIMETER NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the powertrain control module (PCM), should only be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200 Digital Multimeter (DMM). The J 39200 instruction manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminage even though voltage is present. The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity. IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading. Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the measurement. Engine - Valve Lifter Tick Noise At Start Up Lifter / Lash Adjuster: Customer Interest Engine - Valve Lifter Tick Noise At Start Up TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 10-06-01-007C Date: February 09, 2011 Subject: Active Fuel Management (AFM) Engine, Valve Lifter Tick Noise at Start Up When Engine Has Been Off for 2 Hours or More (Evaluate Noise and/or Replace Valve Lifters) Models: 2007 Buick Rainier 2009 Buick LaCrosse Super, Allure Super (Canada Only) 2007 Cadillac Escalade Built Prior to April 1, 2006 with 6.2L Engine RPO L92 (These engines were built with AFM Hardware but the AFM system was disabled) 2010-2011 Cadillac Escalade, Escalade ESV, Escalade EXT 2007 Chevrolet Monte Carlo 2007-2009 Chevrolet Impala 2007-2011 Chevrolet Avalanche, Silverado, Suburban, Tahoe, TrailBlazer, TrailBlazer EXT 2010-2011 Chevrolet Camaro SS 2007-2011 GMC Envoy, Envoy XL, Sierra, Yukon, Yukon Denali, Yukon XL, Yukon XL Denali 2007-2008 Pontiac Grand Prix 2008-2009 Pontiac G8 2007-2009 Saab 9-7X Equipped with AFM (Active Fuel Management) and V8 Engine RPO L76, L94, L99, LC9, LFA, LH6, LMG, LS4, LY5 or LZ1 Attention: This bulletin only applies to the AFM V8 engines listed above. It DOES NOT apply to Non-AFM Engines. If you are dealing with a Non-AFM engine that is experiencing a similar noise, please refer to Engine Mechanical > Diagnostic Information and Procedures > Symptoms in SI. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add models. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 10-06-01-007B (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). Condition Some customers may comment on an engine valve lifter tick noise that occurs after the engine has been shut off for at least two hours. The tick noise may last from two seconds to ten minutes. Cause This condition may be caused by any of the following: - Aerated oil in the valve lifter body, resulting in the valve lifter being unable to purge the air quickly. - A low engine oil level or incorrect oil viscosity. - Dirty or contaminated oil. - A low internal valve lifter oil reservoir level. - Debris in the valve lifter. - A high valve lifter leak down rate. Correction If the SI diagnostics do not isolate the cause of this valve lifter tick noise and normal oil pressure is noted during the concern, perform the following steps: 1. Inspect the engine oil condition and level. Refer to Owner Manual > Service and Appearance Care > Checking Things Under the Hood > Description and Operation > Engine Oil in SI. ‹› If the engine oil is more than one quart low, an incorrect oil viscosity is being used or if poor quality/contamination is observed, change the oil and filter. Note Page 3801 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the DuraSeal splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of a connector. CPAs are used in all SIR System connectors and also in some connectors of other systems. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals of a connection. TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE CLIPS IMPORTANT: When making a splice in an area that may be exposed to moisture use a crimp and seal splice sleeve instead of a Splice Clip. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. Engine - Valve Lifter Tick Noise At Start Up Engine Oil: Customer Interest Engine - Valve Lifter Tick Noise At Start Up TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 10-06-01-007C Date: February 09, 2011 Subject: Active Fuel Management (AFM) Engine, Valve Lifter Tick Noise at Start Up When Engine Has Been Off for 2 Hours or More (Evaluate Noise and/or Replace Valve Lifters) Models: 2007 Buick Rainier 2009 Buick LaCrosse Super, Allure Super (Canada Only) 2007 Cadillac Escalade Built Prior to April 1, 2006 with 6.2L Engine RPO L92 (These engines were built with AFM Hardware but the AFM system was disabled) 2010-2011 Cadillac Escalade, Escalade ESV, Escalade EXT 2007 Chevrolet Monte Carlo 2007-2009 Chevrolet Impala 2007-2011 Chevrolet Avalanche, Silverado, Suburban, Tahoe, TrailBlazer, TrailBlazer EXT 2010-2011 Chevrolet Camaro SS 2007-2011 GMC Envoy, Envoy XL, Sierra, Yukon, Yukon Denali, Yukon XL, Yukon XL Denali 2007-2008 Pontiac Grand Prix 2008-2009 Pontiac G8 2007-2009 Saab 9-7X Equipped with AFM (Active Fuel Management) and V8 Engine RPO L76, L94, L99, LC9, LFA, LH6, LMG, LS4, LY5 or LZ1 Attention: This bulletin only applies to the AFM V8 engines listed above. It DOES NOT apply to Non-AFM Engines. If you are dealing with a Non-AFM engine that is experiencing a similar noise, please refer to Engine Mechanical > Diagnostic Information and Procedures > Symptoms in SI. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add models. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 10-06-01-007B (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). Condition Some customers may comment on an engine valve lifter tick noise that occurs after the engine has been shut off for at least two hours. The tick noise may last from two seconds to ten minutes. Cause This condition may be caused by any of the following: - Aerated oil in the valve lifter body, resulting in the valve lifter being unable to purge the air quickly. - A low engine oil level or incorrect oil viscosity. - Dirty or contaminated oil. - A low internal valve lifter oil reservoir level. - Debris in the valve lifter. - A high valve lifter leak down rate. Correction If the SI diagnostics do not isolate the cause of this valve lifter tick noise and normal oil pressure is noted during the concern, perform the following steps: 1. Inspect the engine oil condition and level. Refer to Owner Manual > Service and Appearance Care > Checking Things Under the Hood > Description and Operation > Engine Oil in SI. ‹› If the engine oil is more than one quart low, an incorrect oil viscosity is being used or if poor quality/contamination is observed, change the oil and filter. Note Page 1345 2. Locate the nose piece locking tabs that are positioned on the side of the connector nose piece. The connector nose piece acts as a terminal positive assurance (TPA) and may be referred to as such. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to push in one of the locking tabs while gently pulling on the same side of the nose piece. 4. Repeat the procedure for the other locking tab and remove the nose piece. 5. Remove the wire dress cover. The following is a general procedure for wire dress cover removal. Use this procedure as a guide, some dress cover removal procedures may vary. 6. Use fingers to squeeze the 2 locking legs of the cover. Page 107 Method 3 The Gen 6.1 version of OnStar(R) does not require the use of the Service Programming System (SPS) to change the voice recognition system. However, there are three ways to change the language. Disclaimer Page 6096 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert terminal into the appropriate terminal holder until it hits bottom and stops. The correct terminal holder is determined by the wire size. Also ensure that the terminals wings are pointing towards the former on the tool and the release locator. 5. Insert the stripped cable into the terminal. Insulation should be visible on both sides of the terminal insulation wings. 6. Compress the handles until the ratchet automatically releases. 7. Place the terminal into the appropriate cavity and assemble the connector. Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO-PACK 100W) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W connectors. These connectors are very similar but use different terminals and have some minor physical differences also. Page 6460 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Kostal Connectors KOSTAL CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 2184 1. Locate the air flow direction arrow (2) on the MAF/IAT sensor. 2. Install the MAF/IAT sensor on to the air cleaner housing. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 3. Tighten the clamp securing the MAF/IAT sensor to the air cleaner housing. Tighten the clamp to 7 N.m (62 lb in). 4. Install the air cleaner outlet duct. 5. Install the air cleaner outlet duct bolt. Tighten the bolt to 10 N.m (89 lb in). 6. Tighten the clamps at the MAF/IAT sensor and the throttle body. Tighten the clamps to 7 N.m (62 lb in). Page 211 2. Locate the nose piece locking tabs that are positioned on the side of the connector nose piece. The connector nose piece acts as a terminal positive assurance (TPA) and may be referred to as such. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to push in one of the locking tabs while gently pulling on the same side of the nose piece. 4. Repeat the procedure for the other locking tab and remove the nose piece. 5. Remove the wire dress cover. The following is a general procedure for wire dress cover removal. Use this procedure as a guide, some dress cover removal procedures may vary. 6. Use fingers to squeeze the 2 locking legs of the cover. Page 2549 Page 2251 View of typical connector. View of connector in released position. 1. Locate the assist lever at the back of the connector. Move the assist lever to the rear position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the dress cover. Page 4960 6. Gently pry the plastic terminal retainer down and carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (16-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, pull the two connector halves apart. Page 5506 1. Locate the air flow direction arrow (2) on the MAF/IAT sensor. 2. Install the MAF/IAT sensor on to the air cleaner housing. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 3. Tighten the clamp securing the MAF/IAT sensor to the air cleaner housing. Tighten the clamp to 7 N.m (62 lb in). 4. Install the air cleaner outlet duct. 5. Install the air cleaner outlet duct bolt. Tighten the bolt to 10 N.m (89 lb in). 6. Tighten the clamps at the MAF/IAT sensor and the throttle body. Tighten the clamps to 7 N.m (62 lb in). Page 1897 3. Remove the dress cover by using a flat-blade tool to release the connector locking tabs and pulling off the dress cover. 4. Relieve the tension on the nose piece retainers by inserting J-38125-12A (12094429) into the single retainer slot on the end of the nose piece and gently prying out the locking tab. Repeat the process for both of the nose piece locking tabs on the opposite side of the nose piece. Page 403 2. Locate the two indents of the terminal position assurance (TPA) located on the bottom of the connector body. Page 6526 MEASURING FREQUENCY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal. IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM to autorange to an appropriate range. 1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency measured. Measuring Voltage MEASURING VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit. 1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods: - Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. - Turn ON the engine. - Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls. - Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested. 3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The DMM displays the voltage measured at that point. Measuring Voltage Drop MEASURING VOLTAGE DROP NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points. Probing Electrical Connectors PROBING ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS Page 7631 - Yazaki has a wedge or arrow shape, similar to that shown. Delphi Connectors (Micro .64) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro 64 connectors. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. The lever lock may be located on the top or sides of the wire dress cover. Page 6020 11. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 12. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 13. Center the high temperature SCT1 shrink tube over the DuraSeal splice sleeve. 14. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the high temperature heat shrink tubing. 15. Gradually move the heat from the center to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 16. Replace any reflective tape and clips that may have been remove during the repair. Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation REPAIRING DAMAGED WIRE INSULATION Wire Size Conversion Page 2825 Behind The Center Of The I/P (With RPO Code X88) Page 3150 Allow at least a two hour soak time between engine OFF and start up when evaluating the tick noise. 2. Start the engine and evaluate the valve lifter tick noise. ‹› If the valve lifter tick noise is still present, replace all 16 valve lifters. Refer to Valve Lifter Replacement in SI. Parts Information Note A V8 AFM engine requires 8 AFM lifters and 8 non-AFM lifters for a total of 16 lifters. Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use: Warranty Information (Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 2608 View of typical connector. View of connector in released position. 1. Locate the assist lever at the back of the connector. Move the assist lever to the rear position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the dress cover. Page 3533 up, allowing tire air pressure to increase above the threshold causing the light to go off. Properly adjusting all tire air pressures to the recommended levels will correct this (Refer to the Tire and Loading Information Label on the driver side door). - More detailed information can be found in the Owner Manual. - Service is not covered under warranty - this maintenance is the responsibility of the owner. - Give the customer a copy of the "GM Customer TPMS Information". For more detailed information, refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 07-03-16-004C and TPMS Training Course 13044.12T2. Tire Pressure Light At key on, without starting the vehicle: Steady Solid Glowing TPM Indicator If the TPM indicator appears as a steady glowing yellow lamp (as above), the system is functioning properly and you should add air to the tires to correct this condition. Blinking TPM Indicator If the TPM indicator appears as a BLINKING yellow lamp for one minute and then stays on solid, diagnostic service is needed. The Effect of Outside Temperature on Tire Pressures Important: As a rule of thumb, tire pressure will change about 7kPa (1 psi) for every 6°C (10°F) decrease in temperature - Tire pressure will drop when it gets colder outside, and rise when it gets warmer. Under certain situations such as extreme outside temperature changes, the system may bring on a solid light with a check tire pressure message. This should be considered normal and the system is working properly. The light will turn off upon adding the proper amount of air to the tires (refer to the Tire & Loading Information label in the driver's door opening). When properly adjusting tire air pressure, the following steps are important to help optimize the system and prolong bringing a tire pressure light on: ^ Use an accurate, high quality tire pressure gauge. ^ Never set the tire pressure below the specified placard value regardless of tire temperature or ambient temperature. ^ Tire pressure should be set to the specified placard pressure at the lowest seasonal temperature the vehicle will encounter during operation. Page 8610 Knock Sensor: Service and Repair Knock Sensor Replacement (Right Side) Knock Sensor Replacement (Right Side) Removal Procedure 1. Disconnect the electrical connector (3) from the knock sensor (2). 2. Remove the knock sensor bolt (1). 3. Remove the knock sensor (2) from the engine block. Installation Procedure 1. Position the knock sensor (2) on the engine block. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Install the knock sensor bolt (1). Tighten the bolt (1) to 20 N.m (15 lb ft). 3. Connect the electrical connector (3) to the knock sensor (2). Page 7573 Data Communication Diagram 3 Locations: The locations for the Connectors, Grounds, Splices, and Grommets shown within these diagrams can be found via their numbers at Vehicle Locations. See: Locations Page 6683 - Most Molex connectors will have the Molex logo on the dresscover of the connector. In some cases the connectors may have MX followed by another letter. The third letter indicates where the connector was made. A connector with MXD is a Molex connector made in Detroit. Sumitomo has a unique symbol on their connector and possibly a part number. The symbol is similar to that of a diamond lying on its side, similar to that shown. The logo could appear anywhere but the most common place is at the wire side of the housing. Tyco/AMP has many different and unique connector designs. Some may or may not have identifiable marks on them. Page 2435 Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. For connectors with a bolt in the dress cover, turn the bolt counterclockwise to remove the connector from the component. 2. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. Page 7161 3. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. View showing depressing of the lever lock release tab. Page 1958 Page 3202 Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Hydraulic Brake System Bleeding Manual Hydraulic Brake System Bleeding (Manual) Caution: Refer to Brake Fluid Irritant Caution. Notice: Refer to Brake Fluid Effects on Paint and Electrical Components Notice. Notice: When adding fluid to the brake master cylinder reservoir, use only Delco Supreme 11(R), GM P/N 12377967 (Canadian P/N 992667), or equivalent DOT-3 brake fluid from a clean, sealed brake fluid container. The use of any type of fluid other than the recommended type of brake fluid, may cause contamination which could result in damage to the internal rubber seals and/or rubber linings of hydraulic brake system components. 1. Place a clean shop cloth beneath the brake master cylinder to prevent brake fluid spills. 2. With the ignition OFF and the brakes cool, apply the brakes 3-5 times, or until the brake pedal effort increases significantly, in order to deplete the brake booster power reserve. 3. If you have performed a brake master cylinder bench bleeding on this vehicle, or if you disconnected the brake pipes from the master cylinder, you must perform the following steps: 1. Ensure that the brake master cylinder reservoir is full to the maximum-fill level. If necessary add Delco Supreme 11(R), GM P/N 12377967 (Canadian P/N 992667), or equivalent DOT-3 brake fluid from a clean, sealed brake fluid container. If removal of the reservoir cap and diaphragm is necessary, clean the outside of the reservoir on and around the cap prior to removal. 2. With the rear brake pipe installed securely to the master cylinder, loosen and separate the front brake pipe from the front port of the brake master cylinder. 3. Allow a small amount of brake fluid to gravity bleed from the open port of the master cylinder. 4. Reconnect the brake pipe to the master cylinder port and tighten securely. 5. Have an assistant slowly depress the brake pedal fully and maintain steady pressure on the pedal. 6. Loosen the same brake pipe to purge air from the open port of the master cylinder. 7. Tighten the brake pipe, then have the assistant slowly release the brake pedal. 8. Wait 15 seconds, then repeat steps 3.3-3.7 until all air is purged from the same port of the master cylinder. 9. With the front brake pipe installed securely to the master cylinder, after all air has been purged from the front port of the master cylinder, loosen and separate the rear brake pipe from the master cylinder, then repeat steps 3.3-3.8. 10. After completing the final master cylinder port bleeding procedure, ensure that both of the brake pipe-to-master cylinder fittings are properly tightened. 4. Fill the brake master cylinder reservoir with Delco Supreme 11(R), GM P/N 12377967 (Canadian P/N 992667), or equivalent DOT-3 brake fluid from a clean, sealed brake fluid container. Ensure that the brake master cylinder reservoir remains at least half-full during this bleeding procedure. Add fluid as needed to maintain the proper level. Clean the outside of the reservoir on and around the reservoir cap prior to removing the cap and diaphragm. 5. Install a proper box-end wrench onto the RIGHT REAR wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve. 6. Install a transparent hose over the end of the bleeder valve. 7. Submerge the open end of the transparent hose into a transparent container partially filled with Delco Supreme 11(R), GM P/N 12377967 (Canadian P/N 992667), or equivalent DOT-3 brake fluid from a clean, sealed brake fluid container. 8. Have an assistant slowly depress the brake pedal fully and maintain steady pressure on the pedal. 9. Loosen the bleeder valve to purge air from the wheel hydraulic circuit. 10. Tighten the bleeder valve, then have the assistant slowly release the brake pedal. 11. Wait 15 seconds, then repeat steps 8-10 until all air is purged from the same wheel hydraulic circuit. 12. With the right rear wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve tightened securely, after all air has been purged from the right rear hydraulic circuit install a proper box-end wrench onto the LEFT REAR wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve. 13. Install a transparent hose over the end of the bleeder valve, then repeat steps 7-11. 14. With the left rear wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve tightened securely, after all air purged from the left rear hydraulic circuit, install a proper box-end wrench onto the RIGHT FRONT wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve. 15. Install a transparent hose over the end of the bleeder valve, then repeat steps 7-11. 16. With the right front wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve tightened securely, after all air has been purged from the right front hydraulic circuit, install a proper box-end wrench onto the LEFT FRONT wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve. 17. Install a transparent hose over the end of the bleeder valve, then repeat steps 7-11. 18. After completing the final wheel hydraulic circuit bleeding procedure, ensure that each of the 4 wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valves are properly tightened. 19. Fill the brake master cylinder reservoir to the maximum-fill level with Delco Supreme 11(R), GM P/N 12377967 (Canadian P/N 992667), or equivalent DOT-3 brake fluid from a clean, sealed brake fluid container. 20. Slowly depress and release the brake pedal. Observe the feel of the brake pedal. 21. If the brake pedal feels spongy, repeat the bleeding procedure again. If the brake pedal still feels spongy after repeating the bleeding procedure, perform the following steps: 1. Inspect the brake system for external leaks. Refer to Brake System External Leak Inspection. Page 854 TERMINAL REMOVAL Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors. 1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA) device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1). 3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 4. Gently pull the cable and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector. 5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal, refer to Terminal Repair. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3. Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector. REINSTALLING TERMINAL 1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly, refer to Wiring Repairs. 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3. Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) DELPHI CONNECTORS (WEATHER PACK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 4856 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Start in the middle and gradually move the heat barrel to the open ends of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Heated Oxygen Sensor Wiring Repairs HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being obstructed. If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. - Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks, etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire. - Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance. - To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector. Page 5785 1 - Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor 2 - Knock Sensor (KS) 2 - Right 3 - Engine Harness 4 Starter 5 - Engine Page 5454 REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. The release tab is located on the top of the wiredress cover. View of connector in released position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Page 4676 US English/Metric Conversion US English/Metric Conversion Page 7771 11. Insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) into the 2 triangular cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 12. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE 1. Prior to installation the terminal must be aligned so the (1) coding lugs align with the (2) coding grooves on the connector. 2. Once the terminal is aligned, slide the terminal into the cavity until the retainer has engaged in the cavity of the connector. 3. Slide the TPA in the connector body and seat it using a small flat bladed tool. The TPA is seated when it is flush with the contact housing. 4. Secure the wires to the connector body using a tie wrap and replace the dress cover and grommet. Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) BOSCH CONNECTORS (2.8 JPT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Pull out the slider on the connector position assurance (CPA) until it is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 5212 9. The illustration shows a cutaway view of the connector to aid the technician in releasing the terminal retainer. 10. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Terminal Position Assurance Locks TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Tyco/Amp Connectors (CM 42-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (CM 42-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the connector body and pull the CPA out. The CPA is on the wire harness side of connector. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 2177 6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias. Reference the appropriate service manual wiring schematic to obtain the correct diode installation position. 7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for the soldering equipment. 8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed. 9. IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode attachment points with tape. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape. Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable SPLICING TWISTED OR SHIELDED CABLE Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable. 1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splice is made. 3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire. Staggering the splices by 65 mm (2.5 in) is recommended. 4. IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical contact with the drain wire. Re-assemble the cable. Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape. - Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1). - Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire. - Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape. Page 5479 5. While pushing the terminal forward, insert the J 38125-24 in the release cavity above the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (43-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Page 7174 - In some cases Delphi will actually be printed on the connector. If Delphi is not printed on the connector, look for PED. In both cases there is no specific orientation for Delphi or PED and they can appear anywhere on the connector. - FCI connectors may have the FCI logo on their connectors. The logo is the letters FCI with an "A" above it. - JAE connector have JAE in small letters on their connectors. Page 8016 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert terminal into the appropriate terminal holder until it hits bottom and stops. The correct terminal holder is determined by the wire size. Also ensure that the terminals wings are pointing towards the former on the tool and the release locator. 5. Insert the stripped cable into the terminal. Insulation should be visible on both sides of the terminal insulation wings. 6. Compress the handles until the ratchet automatically releases. 7. Place the terminal into the appropriate cavity and assemble the connector. Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO-PACK 100W) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W connectors. These connectors are very similar but use different terminals and have some minor physical differences also. Page 6124 7. The illustration above identifies the entry canal where the terminal release tool will be inserted, and the terminal cavity. - Terminal (1) - Entry Canal (2) 8. Insert the J-38125-553 (15315247) tool into the entry canal and pry up on the terminal retainer. The terminal retainer is a small plastic piece on the top of the terminal. The terminal retainer must be held up while the terminal is pulled out of the connector. Coolant Heater Replacement (LH6 and LS2) Engine Block Heater: Service and Repair Coolant Heater Replacement (LH6 and LS2) Coolant Heater Replacement (LH6 and LS2) Removal Procedure 1. Drain the cooling system. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System (LL8) Draining and Filling Cooling System (LH6, LS2). 2. Raise and suitably support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 3. Disconnect the coolant heater (1) electrical connector. Important: Do not score the surface of the engine block hole when removing the coolant heater. 4. Remove the coolant heater from the engine block. 5. Remove any burrs, sealer, paint or other rough spots. Installation Procedure Page 5544 11. Insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) into the 2 triangular cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 12. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE 1. Prior to installation the terminal must be aligned so the (1) coding lugs align with the (2) coding grooves on the connector. 2. Once the terminal is aligned, slide the terminal into the cavity until the retainer has engaged in the cavity of the connector. 3. Slide the TPA in the connector body and seat it using a small flat bladed tool. The TPA is seated when it is flush with the contact housing. 4. Secure the wires to the connector body using a tie wrap and replace the dress cover and grommet. Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) BOSCH CONNECTORS (2.8 JPT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Pull out the slider on the connector position assurance (CPA) until it is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 7058 2. Locate the two indents of the terminal position assurance (TPA) located on the bottom of the connector body. Page 8126 Refer to the following table as a guide in selecting the correct test adapter for front probing connectors: Backprobe IMPORTANT: Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures. - Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector. - Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large of a test probe. - After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected, test for proper terminal contact. Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the connector. Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure SCAN TOOL SNAPSHOT PROCEDURE Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used Page 6443 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert terminal into the appropriate terminal holder until it hits bottom and stops. The correct terminal holder is determined by the wire size. Also ensure that the terminals wings are pointing towards the former on the tool and the release locator. 5. Insert the stripped cable into the terminal. Insulation should be visible on both sides of the terminal insulation wings. 6. Compress the handles until the ratchet automatically releases. 7. Place the terminal into the appropriate cavity and assemble the connector. Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO-PACK 100W) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W connectors. These connectors are very similar but use different terminals and have some minor physical differences also. Page 722 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the TPA. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the nose piece. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. Page 878 3. Use a small flat-bladed tool to gently pry off the dress cover by inserting the tool under the cover opposite the harness side and prying up. 4. Remove the cover. 5. Using a small flat-bladed tool, push on the side of the nose piece retainer while pushing the nose piece forward with your thumb. This will release the terminal position assurance (TPA). 6. Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) into the corresponding terminal release cavity. The release cavities are the 2 center rows of cavities on one half of the connector. Page 8022 TERMINAL REMOVAL Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors. 1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA) device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1). 3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 4. Gently pull the cable and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector. 5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal, refer to Terminal Repair. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3. Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector. REINSTALLING TERMINAL 1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly, refer to Wiring Repairs. 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3. Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) DELPHI CONNECTORS (WEATHER PACK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 6276 6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias. Reference the appropriate service manual wiring schematic to obtain the correct diode installation position. 7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for the soldering equipment. 8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed. 9. IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode attachment points with tape. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape. Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable SPLICING TWISTED OR SHIELDED CABLE Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable. 1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splice is made. 3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire. Staggering the splices by 65 mm (2.5 in) is recommended. 4. IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical contact with the drain wire. Re-assemble the cable. Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape. - Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1). - Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire. - Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape. Page 8891 Checking Aftermarket Accessories CHECKING AFTERMARKET ACCESSORIES Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits: - CAUTION: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol. - NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice. OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol. Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the cause of the problems. Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include: Power feeds connected to points other than the battery - Antenna location - Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring - Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line - Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories. Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions INDUCING INTERMITTENT FAULT CONDITIONS TOOLS REQUIRED J 25070 Heat Gun Many intermittent open or shorted circuits are affected by harness/connector movement that is caused by vibration, engine torque, bumps/rough pavement, etc. In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness if the malfunction appears to be Page 2049 If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the DuraSeal splice sleeves. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: - Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. - Do not use the crimp and DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 to crimp DuraSeal splice sleeve. In order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 6346 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. JST Connectors JST CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, remove the connector from the component. Page 8979 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches, and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original. - The wires insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the possibility of fuel contact. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1). 5. Select the proper duraseal splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool. Refer to the Crimp and Seal Splice Table. 6. Place the duraseal splice sleeve in the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115) crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 7. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to hold the duraseal splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 8. Insert the wires into the duraseal splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel in order to prevent the wire from passing through the splice (3). 9. Close the handles of the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115), until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is applied to the splice sleeve. 10. Shrink the insulation around the splice. - Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. - Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Splicing Inline Harness Diodes SPLICING INLINE HARNESS DIODES Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure. 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode. 2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool. 5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode. Page 8069 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the DuraSeal splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of a connector. CPAs are used in all SIR System connectors and also in some connectors of other systems. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals of a connection. TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE CLIPS IMPORTANT: When making a splice in an area that may be exposed to moisture use a crimp and seal splice sleeve instead of a Splice Clip. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. Page 532 6. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by pressing on the tang. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (SENSOR) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) tool into the cavity on the lower right hand face of the connector until the terminal release tang access panel slides over. Page 2858 Alignment: Service and Repair Measuring Wheel Alignment Measuring Wheel Alignment Steering and vibration complaints are not always the result of improper alignment. One possible cause is wheel and tire imbalance. Another possibility is tire lead due to worn or improperly manufactured tires. Lead/pull is defined as follows: At a constant highway speed on a typical straight road, lead/pull is the amount of effort required at the steering wheel to maintain the vehicle's straight path. Lead is the vehicle deviation from a straight path on a level road without pressure on the steering wheel. Refer to Radial Tire Lead/Pull Correction in order to determine if the vehicle has a tire lead problem. Before performing any adjustment affecting wheel alignment, perform the following inspections and adjustments in order to ensure correct alignment readings: ^ Inspect the tires for the proper inflation and irregular tire wear. Refer to Vehicle Certification, Tire Place Card, Anti-Theft, and Service Parts ID Label and Tire Diagnosis - Irregular or Premature Wear. ^ Inspect the runout of the wheels and the tires. Refer to Tire and Wheel Runout Specifications. ^ Inspect the wheel bearings for backlash and excessive play. Refer to Wheel Bearings Diagnosis. ^ Inspect the ball joints and tie rod ends for looseness or wear. ^ Inspect the control arms and stabilizer shaft for looseness or wear. ^ Inspect the steering gear for looseness at the frame. Refer to Fastener Tightening Specifications. ^ Inspect the struts/shock absorbers for wear, leaks, and any noticeable noises. Refer to Suspension Strut and Shock Absorber Testing - On Vehicle. ^ Inspect the vehicle trim height. Refer to Trim Height Inspection. ^ Inspect the steering wheel for excessive drag or poor return due to stiff or rusted linkage or suspension components. ^ Inspect the fuel level. The fuel tank should be full or the vehicle should have a compensating load added. Give consideration to excess loads, such as tool boxes, sample cases, etc. If normally carried in the vehicle, these items should remain in the vehicle during alignment adjustments. Give consideration also to the condition of the equipment being used for the alignment. Follow the equipment manufacturer's instructions. Satisfactory vehicle operation may occur over a wide range of alignment settings. However, if the setting exceeds the service allowable specifications, correct the alignment to the service preferred specifications. Refer to Wheel Alignment Specifications. Perform the following steps in order to measure the front and rear alignment angles: 1. Install the alignment equipment according to the manufacturer's instructions. 2. Jounce the front and the rear bumpers 3 times prior to checking the wheel alignment. 3. Measure the alignment angles and record the readings. Important: When performing adjustments to vehicles requiring a 4-wheel alignment, set the rear wheel alignment angles first in order to obtain proper front alignment angles. 4. Adjust alignment angles to vehicle specification, if necessary. Refer to Wheel Alignment Specifications. Page 2434 Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested: - Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. - Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a component or to other harnesses. - If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A TEST LAMP TOOLS REQUIRED J 35616-200 Test Light - Probe Kit NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminate even though voltage is present. The J 35616-200 is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair of leads. To properly operate this tool use the following procedures. When testing for voltage: 1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested. When testing for ground: 1. Attach one lead to battery positive voltage. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where ground should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is ground at the point being tested. Using Connector Test Adapters USING CONNECTOR TEST ADAPTERS NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Using Fused Jumper Wires USING FUSED JUMPER WIRES TOOLS REQUIRED J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged. The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested. AFL/ECP Connectors AFL/EPC CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 9028 Connector Anatomy Connector Repairs contains a list of all connector repairs. The connector repairs are listed by the connector manufacturer and then by connector type. If the technician cannot identify the manufacturer of the connector, refer to Identifying Connectors below. Knowing the connector manufacturer will assist in finding the correct connector repair from the following list: - Connector Position Assurance Locks - Terminal Position Assurance Locks - Bosch Connectors (0.64) Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) Bosch Connectors (BSK) Bosch Connectors (ECM) - Delphi Connectors (Micro.64) Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) Delphi Connectors (12-Way) - Tyco/AMP Connectors (CM 42-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) Tyco/AMP Connectors (025 Cap) Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) - Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) - Repairing Connector Terminals IDENTIFYING CONNECTORS Knowing the connector manufacturer is helpful when trying to locating the correct connector repair procedure. There are many different connector designs used on GM vehicles and it is sometimes difficult to identify the connector manufacturer. The information in this document should help with the identification of connector manufactures. The following connector manufacturers make most of the connectors found in GM vehicles: AFL/EPC (Alcoa Fujikura Ltd./Engineered Plastics Components) - Bosch - Delphi - FCI (Framatome Connectors International) - JAE (Japan Aviation Electronics) - JST (Japan Solderless Terminals) Page 730 View of typical connector. View of connector in released position. 1. Locate the assist lever at the back of the connector. Move the assist lever to the rear position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the dress cover. Page 5352 4. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the rear of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. 5. Once the locking tabs are unlocked, slide the inner connector out of the rear of the connector housing. Page 4927 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) and slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. Page 5921 1. Apply sealant to the threads of the oil pressure sensor. Refer to Sealers, Adhesives, and Lubricants for the correct part number. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Using J 41712 or equivalent, install the oil pressure sensor. Tighten the sensor to 35 N.m (26 lb ft). 3. Connect the oil pressure sensor electrical connector (1). 4. Install the intake manifold. Refer to Intake Manifold Replacement. Page 4392 - Most Molex connectors will have the Molex logo on the dresscover of the connector. In some cases the connectors may have MX followed by another letter. The third letter indicates where the connector was made. A connector with MXD is a Molex connector made in Detroit. Sumitomo has a unique symbol on their connector and possibly a part number. The symbol is similar to that of a diamond lying on its side, similar to that shown. The logo could appear anywhere but the most common place is at the wire side of the housing. Tyco/AMP has many different and unique connector designs. Some may or may not have identifiable marks on them. Page 3687 Models Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years, models and additional information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 00-00-89-008E (Section 00 - General Information). Some customers may want to tow their vehicle behind another vehicle with all FOUR tires on the ground. This is referred to as "dinghy" towing. Towing in this manner is acceptable only on the certain vehicles. The vehicle should be properly equipped and prepared as described below. The passenger cars listed above are the vehicles that CAN be dinghy towed. Passenger cars not listed above are vehicles where dinghy towing is not permitted or recommended. Certain 4WD trucks can be dinghy towed depending on the transfer case option. Rear wheel drive and AWD trucks should NOT be dinghy towed. Refer to the truck models and transfer case options below. Please refer to the applicable vehicle Owner's Manual before towing. Passenger Cars Page 9004 Page 5550 - Most Molex connectors will have the Molex logo on the dresscover of the connector. In some cases the connectors may have MX followed by another letter. The third letter indicates where the connector was made. A connector with MXD is a Molex connector made in Detroit. Sumitomo has a unique symbol on their connector and possibly a part number. The symbol is similar to that of a diamond lying on its side, similar to that shown. The logo could appear anywhere but the most common place is at the wire side of the housing. Tyco/AMP has many different and unique connector designs. Some may or may not have identifiable marks on them. Page 2045 The engine harness may be repaired using the J-38125. High Temperature Wiring Repairs HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperatures, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time may use materials i.e. wires, connectors, and shielding that has a higher heat rating than typical wiring. When making a repair in a high temperature area observe the following: Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature to replace any damaged wire. - Replace any heat shielding that is removed. - Cover any DuraSeal splice sleeves with SCT1 shrink tubing (available in the J-38125 Terminal Repair kit). - After making a wiring repair, ensure that the location of the wiring is not moved closer to the heat source. IDENTIFYING HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperature, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time need special considerations when making wiring repairs. Areas that may be exposed to higher temperatures can be identified by heat resistant materials that are being used in those areas. These materials may include heat reflective tape, moon tape, and high temperature shrink tubing. Also conduit and other protective coverings may be used. Because conduit or similar coverings are used throughout the vehicle regardless of the temperature, it may be necessary for the technician to determine if an area is exposed to excessive heat before making a wiring repair. Obvious areas of consideration would be any area located near the exhaust manifolds, catalytic converter, and exhaust pipes. The J-38125 contains much of the material you will need to perform repairs on areas exposed to high heat. The kit contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves to crimp and seal connections - High temperature SCT1 shrink tubing to protect the splice sleeves - A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct crimp tool to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools to remove the terminals from the connectors The J-38125 does not contain wire that is suitable to high temperature exposure. Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature of the same or larger gage size as the original wire when repair damage wire. Also replace any reflective tape that you remove during the repair. HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature rating of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125 and then encapsulate the splice sleeve using the high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the order listed. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip keeping all of the wire strands intact. Page 1378 3. Ensure that the terminal release tang access panel is in the correct location to access the terminals. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) into the terminal release tang access slot located behind the access panel of the connector and press down on the terminal while carefully pulling the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Tyco/AMP Connectors (0.25 Cap) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (025 CAP) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component by pressing down on the connector position assurance (CPA). Page 7750 Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Page 2896 Air Filter Element: Service and Repair Air Cleaner Element Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Remove the air cleaner outlet duct. 2. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF)/intake air temperature (IAT) sensor electrical connector (1). 3. Remove the radiator support diagonal brace. 4. Loosen the 4 air cleaner cover retaining screws (1). 5. Remove the air cleaner housing cover (2). Lift and rotate the cover in order to remove the cover from the vehicle. 6. Remove the air filter element (6) and the MAF/IAT sensor (3) from the lower air cleaner housing/washer solvent tank assembly (4). 7. Separate the air filter element (6) from the MAF/IAT sensor (3). 8. Inspect the entire assembly for dust, debris, or water. Clean or replace as necessary. Installation Procedure Page 382 - Most Molex connectors will have the Molex logo on the dresscover of the connector. In some cases the connectors may have MX followed by another letter. The third letter indicates where the connector was made. A connector with MXD is a Molex connector made in Detroit. Sumitomo has a unique symbol on their connector and possibly a part number. The symbol is similar to that of a diamond lying on its side, similar to that shown. The logo could appear anywhere but the most common place is at the wire side of the housing. Tyco/AMP has many different and unique connector designs. Some may or may not have identifiable marks on them. Page 8828 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the rear TPA from the connector. 7. IMPORTANT: The front TPA cannot be removed from the connector. Only move it to the release point. Use a small flat-blade tool to move the front TPA to the release position. 8. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 9. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Molex Connectors Page 1633 5. While pushing the terminal forward, insert the J 38125-24 in the release cavity above the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (43-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Page 1975 Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. For connectors with a bolt in the dress cover, turn the bolt counterclockwise to remove the connector from the component. 2. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. Page 8527 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. 4. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front of the connector. Page 1326 difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Bosch Connectors (ECM) BOSCH CONNECTORS (ECM) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the assist lever on the top of the connector. Move the assist lever to the forward position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 2694 11. Install the 2 bolts (1) securing the seat recliner to the seat adjuster. 12. Install the lumbar adjustment mechanism (1) to the seat adjuster with the 2 screws (2). 13. Install the lumbar cable to the lumbar adjustment mechanism. 14. Install the lumbar knob by pushing the knob straight onto the shaft, if equipped. 15. Install the recliner handle. 16. Install the front, rear, and side J-strips (1, 2) to the underside of the seat. 17. Install the seat in the vehicle. Page 5165 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (BSK) BOSCH CONNECTORS (BSK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 3. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 4. Insert the J 38125-561 tool into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 5. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is Page 32 THIS PROGRAM IS IN EFFECT UNTIL APRIL 30, 2011. Condition Certain 2002-2009 model year vehicles equipped with OnStar(R) may have a condition in which the vehicle's OnStar(R) system repeatedly makes incomplete calls to OnStar(R) without the vehicle's occupant(s) input or knowledge. Customer initiated Blue Button call, Emergency calls, and Automatic Crash Notification calls will also fail to establish a data connection with the OnStar(R) Call Center. Eventually, the customer's call will connect as a voice only line and the customer will be able to talk with an OnStar(R) advisor; however, the advisor will not get crucial customer data such as vehicle identification and location. Correction Dealers/retailers are to replace the OnStar(R) module (VCIM). Vehicles Involved Involved are certain 2002-2009 model year vehicles equipped with OnStar(R), and built within these VIN breakpoints: Note: Some model years/models have only one vehicle involved. Important Dealers/retailers are to confirm vehicle eligibility prior to beginning repairs by using GMVIS (dealers/retailers using WINS) or the Investigate Vehicle History link (dealers/retailers using GWM). Not all vehicles within the above breakpoints may be involved. For dealers/retailers with involved vehicles, a listing with involved vehicles containing the complete vehicle identification number, customer name, and address information has been prepared and will be provided to dealers/retailers through the GM GlobalConnect Recall Reports. Dealers/retailers will not have a report available if they have no involved vehicles currently assigned. The listing may contain customer names and addresses obtained from Motor Vehicle Registration Records. The use of such motor vehicle registration data for any purpose other than follow-up necessary to complete this program is a violation of law in several states/provinces/countries. Accordingly, you are urged to limit the use of this report to the follow-up necessary to complete this program. Parts Information US: OnStar(R) modules required for this program are to be obtained by contacting Autocraft Electronics via the web at www.autocraft.com, and selecting the catalog item that contains bulletin number 10037 (or PIC 4893B), or by calling 1-800-336-3998. Dealer must provide the VIN, R.O. number, and the current vehicle mileage. Canada: OnStar(R) modules required for this program are to be obtained by contacting MASS Electronics at 1-877-410-6277. Dealer must provide the VIN, R.O. number, and the current vehicle mileage. DO NOT ORDER ONSTAR(R) MODULES FROM GENERAL MOTORS CUSTOMER CARE AND AFTERSALES (GMCC&A;), SATURN SERVICE PARTS OPERATION (SSPO), OR THE TECHNICAL ASSISTANCE CENTER (TAC). Courtesy Transportation The General Motors Courtesy Transportation program is intended to minimize customer inconvenience when a vehicle requires a repair that is covered by the New Vehicle Limited Warranties. The availability of courtesy transportation to customers whose vehicles are within the warranty coverage period and involved in a product program is very important in maintaining customer satisfaction. Dealers/retailers are to ensure that these customers understand that shuttle service or some other form of courtesy transportation is available and will be provided at no charge. Dealers should refer to the General Motors Service Policies and Procedures Manual for Courtesy Transportation guidelines. Claim Information 1. Submit a claim using the table below. 2. Courtesy Transportation - For dealers/retailers using WINS, submit using normal labor code; for dealers/retailers using GWM - submit as Net Item under the repair labor code. Page 2755 10. Using the tire machine, rotate the tire/wheel assembly clockwise when transferring the tire bead to the inside of the wheel rim. 11. Position the rim so that the valve stem (1) is situated at the 3 o'clock position relative to the head (2). This will protect the sensor when the bottom bead seats. 12. After the bottom bead is on the wheel, reposition the wheel and tire so that the valve stem is situated at the 9 o'clock position relative to the head. This will protect the sensor while mounting the tire bead to the outside of the wheel. Page 8238 MEASURING FREQUENCY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal. IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM to autorange to an appropriate range. 1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency measured. Measuring Voltage MEASURING VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit. 1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods: - Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. - Turn ON the engine. - Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls. - Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested. 3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The DMM displays the voltage measured at that point. Measuring Voltage Drop MEASURING VOLTAGE DROP NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points. Probing Electrical Connectors PROBING ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS Page 216 The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors. 1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position. 4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool J 38125-10A (GM P/N 12014012-1) into the front (mating end) of the connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal through the back of the connector (2). IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector. 6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. 7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily. 10. Perform system check. Delphi Connectors (12 Way) DELPHI CONNECTORS (12-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. Page 2308 All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system. Specifications Power Steering Fluid: Specifications POWER STEERING SYSTEM GM Power Steering Fluid GM P/N 89021184 (Canadian P/N 89021186) or equivalent. Page 5849 View of typical connector. View of connector in released position. 1. Locate the assist lever at the back of the connector. Move the assist lever to the rear position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the dress cover. Page 5788 Page 6966 Page 2293 Page 7429 Engine Control Module (ECM) C3 (Pin 60 To 73) Page 407 4. Slide the dress cover forward and off of the connector. 5. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front and rear of the connector. Page 4944 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 3729 Release the tabs that are holding the wiredress cover to the connector body. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the slots on both ends of the connector body. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. J 38125-216 can also be used to remove the nose piece. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by lifting the terminal retaining tabs on the inside of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 4445 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Start in the middle and gradually move the heat barrel to the open ends of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Heated Oxygen Sensor Wiring Repairs HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being obstructed. If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. - Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks, etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire. - Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance. - To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector. Page 444 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches, and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original. - The wires insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the possibility of fuel contact. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1). 5. Select the proper duraseal splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool. Refer to the Crimp and Seal Splice Table. 6. Place the duraseal splice sleeve in the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115) crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 7. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to hold the duraseal splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 8. Insert the wires into the duraseal splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel in order to prevent the wire from passing through the splice (3). 9. Close the handles of the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115), until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is applied to the splice sleeve. 10. Shrink the insulation around the splice. - Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. - Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Splicing Inline Harness Diodes SPLICING INLINE HARNESS DIODES Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure. 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode. 2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool. 5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode. Page 6576 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the rear TPA from the connector. 7. IMPORTANT: The front TPA cannot be removed from the connector. Only move it to the release point. Use a small flat-blade tool to move the front TPA to the release position. 8. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 9. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Molex Connectors Memory Seat Module - Driver C1 Memory Seat Module - Driver C1 (w/Memory) Page 2790 8. Carefully squeeze the locking tabs (2) together to disengage the primary lock. 9. Pull the primary lock (1) up. Spring tension will push the end of the cable past the ball stud. Important: If the cable end is pushed rearward past the ball stud during the adjustment procedure, it must be released and allowed to come forward of the ball stud. The cable end must then be pushed back just enough to be installed to the ball stud. 10. Push the end of the cable until it is aligned with the ball stud. 11. Install the cable (4) to the ball stud (6). 12. Seat the primary lock (1) by pressing into the locked position. Locations Steering Mounted Controls Assembly: Locations Secondary/Configurable Control Component Views Steering Wheel and Column Steering Wheel and Column 1 - Steering Wheel Control Switch Assembly - Upper Left (STW) 2 - Passlock Sensor Connector (w/o BAE) 3 - Ignition Key Alarm Switch 4 - Ignition Lock Cylinder Control Actuator 5 - Ignition Lock Cylinder Control Actuator Connector 6 - Ignition Switch 7 - Ignition Key Cylinder 8 - Steering Wheel Control Switch Assembly - Upper Right (STW) 9 - Horn Switch 10 - Steering Wheel Control Switch Assembly - Lower Right (STW) 11 - C277 12 - Steering Wheel Control Switch Assembly - Lower Left (STW) 13 - Turn Signal/Multifunction Switch Page 1233 Stop Lamp Switch Page 6442 4. Once the front 2 locks are unlocked, lift the front of the dress cover and pull it forward. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the small slot on the TPA and pushing down until the TPA releases. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to angle or rock the J 38125-21 tool when inserting it into the connector or the tool may break. Insert the J 38125-21 (GM P/N 15381651-2) tool into the round canal between the terminals cavities at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to repair Micro 64 connector terminals. The Micro 64 connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-64 (M jaw) was developed to crimp Micro 64 terminals. The J 38125-64 crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. The J 38125-64 crimping tool is also designed to crimp both the wire and the insulation at the same time. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro 64 terminals. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. 1. Cut the wire as close to the damaged terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. Page 5670 It is very important to use the correct test adapter when testing for proper terminal contact of fuses and relays in a bussed electrical center (BEC). Use J-35616-35 to test for proper terminal contact. Failure to use J-35616-35 can result in improper diagnosis of the BEC. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Separate the connector halves. 2. Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body. 3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J-38125 , test that the retention force is significantly different between a good terminal and a suspect terminal. Replace the female terminal in question. FLAT WIRE (DOCK AND LOCK) CONNECTORS There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock) connectors on the harness side or the component side. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Remove the component in question. 2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side of the connector as oil from your skin may be a source of contamination as well. 3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other imperfections that could cause poor terminal contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are uniform and free of damage or deformation. 4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the on the flat wire harness connector in order to test the circuit in question. CONTROL MODULE/COMPONENT VOLTAGE AND GROUNDS Poor voltage or ground connections can cause widely varying symptoms. Test all control module voltage supply circuits. Many vehicles have multiple circuits supplying voltage to a control module. Other components in the system may have separate voltage supply circuits that may also need to be tested. Inspect connections at the module/component connectors, fuses, and any intermediate connections between the voltage source and the module/component. A test lamp or a DMM may indicate that voltage is present, but neither tests the ability of the circuit to carry sufficient current. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Power Distribution Schematics. - Test all control module ground and system ground circuits. The control module may have multiple ground circuits. Other components in the system may have separate grounds that may also need to be tested. Inspect grounds for clean and tight connections at the grounding point. Inspect the connections at the component and in splice packs, where applicable. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Ground Distribution Schematics. TEMPERATURE SENSITIVITY - An intermittent condition may occur when a component/connection reaches normal operating temperature. The condition may occur only when the component/connection is cold, or only when the component/connection is hot. - Freeze Frame, Failure Records, Snapshot, or Vehicle Data Recorder data may help with this type of intermittent condition, where applicable. - If the intermittent is related to heat, review the data for a relationship with the following: High ambient temperatures - Underhood/engine generated heat - Circuit generated heat due to a poor connection, or high electrical load - Higher than normal load conditions, towing, etc. - If the intermittent is related to cold, review the data for the following: Low ambient temperatures-In extremely low temperatures, ice may form in a connection or component. Inspect for water intrusion. - The condition only occurs on a cold start. - The condition goes away when the vehicle warms up. - Information from the customer may help to determine if the trouble follows a pattern that is temperature related. - If temperature is suspected of causing an intermittent fault condition, attempt to duplicate the condition. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required. ELECTROMAGNETIC INTERFERENCE (EMI) AND ELECTRICAL NOISE Some electrical components/circuits are sensitive to electromagnetic interference (EMI) or other types of electrical noise. Inspect for the following conditions: A misrouted harness that is too close to high voltage/high current devices such as secondary ignition components, motors, generator etc-These components may induce electrical noise on a circuit that could interfere with normal circuit operation. - Electrical system interference caused by a malfunctioning relay, or a control module driven solenoid or switch-These conditions can cause a sharp electrical surge. Normally, the condition will occur when the malfunctioning component is operating. - Improper installation of non-factory or aftermarket add on accessories such as lights, 2-way radios, amplifiers, electric motors, remote starters, alarm systems, cell phones, etc-These accessories may lead to interference while in use, but do not fail when the accessories are not in use. - Test for an open diode across the A/C compressor clutch and for other open diodes. Some relays may contain a clamping diode. - The generator may be allowing AC noise into the electrical system. INCORRECT CONTROL MODULE - There are only a few situations where reprogramming a control module is appropriate: A new service control module is installed. Page 6951 Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size. REPAIRING A FUSIBLE LINK IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient overload protection. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. Flat Wire Repairs FLAT WIRE REPAIRS NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced. GMLAN Wiring Repairs GMLAN WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The GM Local Area Network (GMLAN) System requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working on GMLAN connectors and terminals. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items in order to repair the GMLAN wiring: Dura Seal splice sleeves - A wire stripping tool - J 38125-8 Crimping Tool (GM P/N 12085115) - J 38125-5 Ultra Torch Special Tool (GM P/N 12085116) The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. - A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors GMLAN REPAIRS IMPORTANT: When making a repair to any GMLAN network, the original wire length after the repair must be the same length as before the repair. If the network is a twisted pair, the twist must be maintained after the repair is completed. GMLAN has 2 types of networks, low speed and high speed. Low speed GMLAN has a single wire and works at slow speeds. High speed GMLAN has 2 wires in a twisted pair and works at higher speeds. For more information on GMLAN, refer to Data Link Communications Description and Operation. GMLAN CONNECTOR TERMINAL REPAIR IMPORTANT: A service terminal can be used to replace damaged connector terminals for both high speed and low speed GMLAN systems. When making a connector terminal repair on a GMLAN high speed system with twisted pair wires, do not untwist the wires more than necessary to make the repair. The terminals in the GMLAN system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are available in the J-38125. If the individual terminals are damaged on any GMLAN connection, use the appropriate connector repair procedure in order to repair the terminal. GMLAN WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 5228 Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size. REPAIRING A FUSIBLE LINK IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient overload protection. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. Flat Wire Repairs FLAT WIRE REPAIRS NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced. GMLAN Wiring Repairs GMLAN WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The GM Local Area Network (GMLAN) System requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working on GMLAN connectors and terminals. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items in order to repair the GMLAN wiring: Dura Seal splice sleeves - A wire stripping tool - J 38125-8 Crimping Tool (GM P/N 12085115) - J 38125-5 Ultra Torch Special Tool (GM P/N 12085116) The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. - A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors GMLAN REPAIRS IMPORTANT: When making a repair to any GMLAN network, the original wire length after the repair must be the same length as before the repair. If the network is a twisted pair, the twist must be maintained after the repair is completed. GMLAN has 2 types of networks, low speed and high speed. Low speed GMLAN has a single wire and works at slow speeds. High speed GMLAN has 2 wires in a twisted pair and works at higher speeds. For more information on GMLAN, refer to Data Link Communications Description and Operation. GMLAN CONNECTOR TERMINAL REPAIR IMPORTANT: A service terminal can be used to replace damaged connector terminals for both high speed and low speed GMLAN systems. When making a connector terminal repair on a GMLAN high speed system with twisted pair wires, do not untwist the wires more than necessary to make the repair. The terminals in the GMLAN system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are available in the J-38125. If the individual terminals are damaged on any GMLAN connection, use the appropriate connector repair procedure in order to repair the terminal. GMLAN WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 3294 7. The illustration above identifies the entry canal where the terminal release tool will be inserted, and the terminal cavity. - Terminal (1) - Entry Canal (2) 8. Insert the J-38125-553 (15315247) tool into the entry canal and pry up on the terminal retainer. The terminal retainer is a small plastic piece on the top of the terminal. The terminal retainer must be held up while the terminal is pulled out of the connector. Cooling System, A/C - Aluminum Heater Cores/Radiators Heater Core: Technical Service Bulletins Cooling System, A/C - Aluminum Heater Cores/Radiators INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 05-06-02-001A Date: July 16, 2008 Subject: Information On Aluminum Heater Core and/or Radiator Replacement Models: 2005 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2003-2005 HUMMER H2 Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the Warranty Information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 05-06-02-001 (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). Important: 2004-05 Chevrolet Aveo (Pontiac Wave, Canada Only) does not use DEX-COOL(R). Refer to the flushing procedure explained later in this bulletin. The following information should be utilized when servicing aluminum heater core and/or radiators on repeat visits. A replacement may be necessary because erosion, corrosion, or insufficient inhibitor levels may cause damage to the heater core, radiator or water pump. A coolant check should be performed whenever a heater core, radiator, or water pump is replaced. The following procedures/ inspections should be done to verify proper coolant effectiveness. Caution: To avoid being burned, do not remove the radiator cap or surge tank cap while the engine is hot. The cooling system will release scalding fluid and steam under pressure if the radiator cap or surge tank cap is removed while the engine and radiator are still hot. Important: If the vehicle's coolant is low, drained out, or the customer has repeatedly added coolant or water to the system, then the system should be completely flushed using the procedure explained later in this bulletin. Technician Diagnosis ^ Verify coolant concentration. A 50% coolant/water solution ensures proper freeze and corrosion protection. Inhibitor levels cannot be easily measured in the field, but can be indirectly done by the measurement of coolant concentration. This must be done by using a Refractometer J 23688 (Fahrenheit scale) or J 26568 (centigrade scale), or equivalent, coolant tester. The Refractometer uses a minimal amount of coolant that can be taken from the coolant recovery reservoir, radiator or the engine block. Inexpensive gravity float testers (floating balls) will not completely analyze the coolant concentration fully and should not be used. The concentration levels should be between 50% and 65% coolant concentrate. This mixture will have a freeze point protection of -34 degrees Fahrenheit (-37 degrees Celsius). If the concentration is below 50%, the cooling system must be flushed. ^ Inspect the coolant flow restrictor if the vehicle is equipped with one. Refer to Service Information (SI) and/or the appropriate Service Manual for component location and condition for operation. ^ Verify that no electrolysis is present in the cooling system. This electrolysis test can be performed before or after the system has been repaired. Use a digital voltmeter set to 12 volts. Attach one test lead to the negative battery post and insert the other test lead into the radiator coolant, making sure the lead does not touch the filler neck or core. Any voltage reading over 0.3 volts indicates that stray current is finding its way into the coolant. Electrolysis is often an intermittent condition that occurs when a device or accessory that is mounted to the radiator is energized. This type of current could be caused from a poorly grounded cooling fan or some other accessory and can be verified by watching the volt meter and turning on and off various accessories or engage the starter motor. Before using one of the following flush procedures, the coolant recovery reservoir must be removed, drained, cleaned and reinstalled before refilling the system. Notice: ^ Using coolant other than DEX‐COOL(R) may cause premature engine, heater core or radiator corrosion. In addition, the engine coolant may require changing sooner, at 30,000 miles (50,000 km) or 24 months, whichever occurs first. Any repairs would not be covered by your warranty. Always use DEX‐COOL(R) (silicate free) coolant in your vehicle. ^ If you use an improper coolant mixture, your engine could overheat and be badly damaged. The repair cost would not be covered by your warranty. Too much water in the mixture can freeze and crack the engine, radiator, heater core and other parts. Page 7875 5. Engage the sliding latch fastening the BCM to the rear electrical center. Slide the latch outboard until the locking tab (1) is fully seated. 6. Install the rear electrical center cover. 7. If replacing the body wiring harness extension on a Chevrolet TrailBlazer or GMC Envoy, position the left hand second seat to a passenger position. 8. If replacing the body wiring harness extension on a Chevrolet TrailBlazer EXT or GMC Envoy XL, install the left second row seat. 9. Connect the negative battery cable. Page 4786 Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested: - Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. - Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a component or to other harnesses. - If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A TEST LAMP TOOLS REQUIRED J 35616-200 Test Light - Probe Kit NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminate even though voltage is present. The J 35616-200 is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair of leads. To properly operate this tool use the following procedures. When testing for voltage: 1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested. When testing for ground: 1. Attach one lead to battery positive voltage. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where ground should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is ground at the point being tested. Using Connector Test Adapters USING CONNECTOR TEST ADAPTERS NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Using Fused Jumper Wires USING FUSED JUMPER WIRES TOOLS REQUIRED J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged. The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested. AFL/ECP Connectors AFL/EPC CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 7836 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the DuraSeal splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of a connector. CPAs are used in all SIR System connectors and also in some connectors of other systems. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals of a connection. TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE CLIPS IMPORTANT: When making a splice in an area that may be exposed to moisture use a crimp and seal splice sleeve instead of a Splice Clip. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. Page 8868 Page 8058 2. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully push the terminal position assurance (TPA) towards the face of the connector on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA is fragile and may break if not done carefully. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. 3. Use the J 38125-215 tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 8228 Page 8059 View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. 4. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers CIRCUIT PROTECTION - CIRCUIT BREAKERS A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types of circuit Page 693 Release the tabs that are holding the wiredress cover to the connector body. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the slots on both ends of the connector body. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. J 38125-216 can also be used to remove the nose piece. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by lifting the terminal retaining tabs on the inside of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Engine - Low Oil Lamp ON/Oil Leaks Oil Pressure Sensor: Customer Interest Engine - Low Oil Lamp ON/Oil Leaks TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 07-06-01-004A Date: November 25, 2008 Subject: All Vortec(R) GEN IV V8 Engines - LY2 LS4 LC9 LH6 LMG LY5 LS2 L76 LY6 L92 LS7, Low Oil Level Indicator Lamp On and/or Engine Oil Leak (Reseal Oil Pressure Sensor) Models Supercede: This bulletin is being updated to include a labor operation number for CTS-V and Corvette models. Please discard Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 07-06-01-004 (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System). Condition Some customers may comment on a low oil level indicator lamp on and/or engine oil leak. Upon further investigation, the technician may find that the oil leak is at the oil pressure sensor that is threaded into the valve lifter oil manifold (VLOM) assembly and/or engine valley cover. Correction If the engine oil leak was found to be at the engine oil pressure sensor, then remove the oil pressure sensor and reseal with a pipe sealant with Teflon or equivalent, P/N 12346004 (in Canada, P/N 10953480). Refer to Engine Oil Pressure Sensor and/or Switch Replacement in SI. Parts Information Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models) Page 3123 Fluid - Differential: Fluid Type Specifications AXLE LUBRICANT FRONT AXLE SAE 75W-90 Synthetic Axle Lubricant (GM Part No. U.S. 89021677, in Canada 89021678) meeting GM Specification 9986115. REAR AXLE (EXCEPT SS MODEL) SAE 75W-90 Synthetic Axle Lubricant (GM Part No. U.S. 89021677, in Canada 89021678) meeting GM Specification 9986115. REAR AXLE (SS MODEL) SAE 75W-90 Synthetic Axle Lubricant (GM Part No. U.S. 89021677, in Canada 89021678) meeting GM Specification 9986115. With a complete drain and refill add 5.5 ounces (163 ml) of Limited-Slip Axle Lubricant Additive (GM Part No. U.S. 1052358, in Canada 992694) where required. Page 5892 Page 888 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert a small flat-blade tool in the slot below the front loaded terminal position assurance (TPA) and pry up. 3. Remove the TPA by pulling it out of the connector. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-553 (GM P/N 15315247) on a slight upward angle into the cavity below the terminal to be removed. Ensure that the pointed on the end of the tool is facing the bottom of the terminal and it stays in contact with the terminal until it stops on the plastic terminal retainer. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 5474 2. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. Knock Sensor Replacement (Left Side) Knock Sensor: Service and Repair Knock Sensor Replacement (Left Side) Knock Sensor Replacement (Left Side) Removal Procedure 1. Remove the mounting bolt for the knock sensor 1. 2. Disconnect the electrical connector of the knock sensor from the engine harness (3). 3. Remove the knock sensor (2) from the engine block (4). Installation Procedure 1. Reconnect the engine harness (3) and the knock sensor (2) electrical connectors. 2. Position the knock sensor 2 on the engine block (4). 3. Install the mounting bolt (1) for the knock sensor 2. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 4. Tighten the knock sensor mounting bolt (1). Tighten the knock sensor mounting bolt to 20 N.m (15 lb ft). Page 6127 7. Pressing the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool in the release cavity of the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and crimper in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (DOOR MODULE) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Side view of connector. View of top of connector. 1. Locate the assist lever and lock on the top of the connector. Page 2375 7. Pressing the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool in the release cavity of the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and crimper in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (DOOR MODULE) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Side view of connector. View of top of connector. 1. Locate the assist lever and lock on the top of the connector. Page 2600 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the TPA. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the nose piece. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. Page 7144 Page 1229 Ambient Light Sensor: Service and Repair AMBIENT LIGHT SENSOR REPLACEMENT REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Remove the windshield garnish moldings. 2. Remove the trim pad. 3. IMPORTANT: Cover the windshield defrost vents with clean shop rags. Disconnect the electrical connector from the sensor. 4. In order to remove the sensor from the trim pad, rotate the sensor counterclockwise 1/4 turn. 5. Remove the sensor from the trim pad. INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 1. Position the sensor to the trim pad. 2. In order to install the sensor to the trim pad, rotate the sensor clockwise 1/4 turn. 3. Position the trim pad to the upper portion of the instrument panel (I/P). 4. Connect the electrical connector to the sensor. 5. Remove the shop rags from the windshield defrost vents. 6. Install the trim pad to the I/P. 7. Install the windshield garnish moldings. Page 5839 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) and slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. Page 1922 If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs SIR/SRS WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS, and the wiring components, such as connectors and terminals. IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system terminals. Use either an SIR/SRS pigtail or a terminated lead from the SIR Repair Kit Tray. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves, in order to repair the SIR/SRS wiring - A special crimping tool - A heat torch - An instruction manual The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides the necessary low resistance contact integrity for these sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors SIR/SRS CONNECTOR REPAIR (PLASTIC BODY AND TERMINAL METAL PIN) The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made with a special plating. This plating provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. Use the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit for repairing SIR/SRS terminals and connectors. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the repair kit. The J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit contains: Various terminated leads for sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) terminal replacement - Various connector positive assurance (CPA) locks for SIR/SRS connectors - Base of steering column pigtail connectors part number 12085514 - Yellow vinyl electrical tape Pigtail repair packs are available for SIR/SRS connectors with eight or less terminals. Only the connector body is available for connectors with more than eight terminals. The terminated leads in the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit can be used to replace damaged terminals when replacing the connector body. SIR/SRS COMPONENT WIRE PIGTAIL REPAIR IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails. A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device, not by a connector. If a wiring pigtail is damaged, you must replace the entire component, with pigtail. The inflatable restraint steering wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component. SIR/SRS WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 2774 12. Install the TCC solenoid with a new O-ring seal to the valve body. 13. Install the TCC solenoid bolts. Tighten the TCC solenoid retaining bolts to 11 N.m (97 lb in). 14. Install the internal wiring harness to the valve body. The internal wiring harness has a tab (1) on the edge of the conduit. 15. Place the tab between the valve body and the pressure switch in the location shown (2). Press the harness into position on the valve body bolt bosses (1, 3). Page 8584 6. Gently pry the plastic terminal retainer down and carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (16-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, pull the two connector halves apart. Page 4472 Radiator Cooling Fan Motor: Diagnostic Aids Arrows and Symbols Arrows and Symbols This Service Data uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations. Arrows and Symbols 1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow Basic Knowledge Required GENERAL ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures contained in the service manual. You should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current (amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram, as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. Decimal and Metric Equivalents Decimal and Metric Equivalents Engine - Noise/Damage Oil Filter Application Importance Oil Filter: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Noise/Damage Oil Filter Application Importance INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 07-06-01-016B Date: July 27, 2009 Subject: Information on Internal Engine Noise or Damage After Oil Filter Replacement Models: 2010 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X Supercede: This bulletin is being updated to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 07-06-01-016A (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). Important Engine damage that is the result of an incorrect or improperly installed engine oil filter is not a warrantable claim. The best way to avoid oil filter quality concerns is to purchase ACDelco(R) oil filters directly from GMSPO. Oil filter misapplication may cause abnormal engine noise or internal damage. Always utilize the most recent parts information to ensure the correct part number filter is installed when replacing oil filters. Do not rely on physical dimensions alone. Counterfeit copies of name brand parts have been discovered in some aftermarket parts systems. Always ensure the parts you install are from a trusted source. Improper oil filter installation may result in catastrophic engine damage. Refer to the appropriate Service Information (SI) installation instructions when replacing any oil filter and pay particular attention to procedures for proper cartridge filter element alignment. If the diagnostics in SI (Engine Mechanical) lead to the oil filter as the cause of the internal engine noise or damage, dealers should submit a field product report. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 02-00-89-002I (Information for Dealers on How to Submit a Field Product Report). Disclaimer Page 7746 Utility/Van Zoning UTILITY/VAN ZONING Page 1162 Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Diagrams HVAC Connector End Views Ambient Air Temperature Sensor Page 6491 The engine harness may be repaired using the J-38125. High Temperature Wiring Repairs HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperatures, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time may use materials i.e. wires, connectors, and shielding that has a higher heat rating than typical wiring. When making a repair in a high temperature area observe the following: Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature to replace any damaged wire. - Replace any heat shielding that is removed. - Cover any DuraSeal splice sleeves with SCT1 shrink tubing (available in the J-38125 Terminal Repair kit). - After making a wiring repair, ensure that the location of the wiring is not moved closer to the heat source. IDENTIFYING HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperature, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time need special considerations when making wiring repairs. Areas that may be exposed to higher temperatures can be identified by heat resistant materials that are being used in those areas. These materials may include heat reflective tape, moon tape, and high temperature shrink tubing. Also conduit and other protective coverings may be used. Because conduit or similar coverings are used throughout the vehicle regardless of the temperature, it may be necessary for the technician to determine if an area is exposed to excessive heat before making a wiring repair. Obvious areas of consideration would be any area located near the exhaust manifolds, catalytic converter, and exhaust pipes. The J-38125 contains much of the material you will need to perform repairs on areas exposed to high heat. The kit contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves to crimp and seal connections - High temperature SCT1 shrink tubing to protect the splice sleeves - A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct crimp tool to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools to remove the terminals from the connectors The J-38125 does not contain wire that is suitable to high temperature exposure. Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature of the same or larger gage size as the original wire when repair damage wire. Also replace any reflective tape that you remove during the repair. HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature rating of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125 and then encapsulate the splice sleeve using the high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the order listed. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip keeping all of the wire strands intact. Page 6496 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the DuraSeal splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of a connector. CPAs are used in all SIR System connectors and also in some connectors of other systems. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals of a connection. TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE CLIPS IMPORTANT: When making a splice in an area that may be exposed to moisture use a crimp and seal splice sleeve instead of a Splice Clip. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. Page 2097 Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested: - Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. - Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a component or to other harnesses. - If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A TEST LAMP TOOLS REQUIRED J 35616-200 Test Light - Probe Kit NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminate even though voltage is present. The J 35616-200 is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair of leads. To properly operate this tool use the following procedures. When testing for voltage: 1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested. When testing for ground: 1. Attach one lead to battery positive voltage. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where ground should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is ground at the point being tested. Using Connector Test Adapters USING CONNECTOR TEST ADAPTERS NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Using Fused Jumper Wires USING FUSED JUMPER WIRES TOOLS REQUIRED J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged. The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested. AFL/ECP Connectors AFL/EPC CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 8204 11. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 12. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 13. Center the high temperature SCT1 shrink tube over the DuraSeal splice sleeve. 14. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the high temperature heat shrink tubing. 15. Gradually move the heat from the center to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 16. Replace any reflective tape and clips that may have been remove during the repair. Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation REPAIRING DAMAGED WIRE INSULATION Wire Size Conversion Page 8125 IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals. Front probe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the connector. IMPORTANT: When probing female 0.64 terminals, it is important to use the correct adapter. There have been some revisions to the test adapter for 0.64 terminals. The proper adapter for 0.64 terminals is the J 35616-64B which has a gold terminal and a black wire between the base and tip. Failure to use the proper test adapter may result in damage to the terminal being tested and improper diagnosis. NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Page 4334 coolant system integrity and will no longer be considered a 5 yr/150,000 mile (240,000 km) coolant. Coolant Removal Services/Recycling The tables include all coolant recycling processes currently approved by GM. Also included is a primary phone number and demographic information. Used DEX-COOL(R) can be combined with used conventional coolant (green) for recycling. Depending on the recycling service and/or equipment, it is then designated as a conventional 2 yr/30,000 mile (50,000 km) coolant or DEX-COOL(R) 5 yr/150,000 mile (240,000 km) coolant. Recycled coolants as designated in this bulletin may be used during the vehicle(s) warranty period. DEX-COOL(R) Recycling The DEX-COOL(R) recycling service listed in Table 2 has been approved for recycling waste engine coolants (DEX-COOL) or conventional) to DEX-COOL(R) with 5 yr/150,000 mile (240,000 km) usability. Recycling Fluid Technologies is the only licensed provider of Recycled DEX-COOL(R) meeting GM6277M specifications and utilizes GM approved inhibitor packages. This is currently a limited program being monitored by GM Service Operations which will be expanded as demand increases. Conventional (Green) Recycling Page 4877 Page 6170 Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Install the 3 APP sensor bolts (1). Tighten the bolts to 20 N.m (15 lb ft). 3. Connect the APP sensor electrical connector. 4. Verify that the vehicle meets the following conditions: * The vehicle is not in a reduced engine power mode. * The ignition is ON. * The engine is OFF. 5. Connect a scan tool in order to test for a proper throttle-opening and throttle-closing range. 6. Operate the accelerator pedal and monitor the throttle angles. The accelerator pedal should operate freely, without binding, between a closed throttle, and a wide open throttle. Page 765 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the DuraSeal splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of a connector. CPAs are used in all SIR System connectors and also in some connectors of other systems. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals of a connection. TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE CLIPS IMPORTANT: When making a splice in an area that may be exposed to moisture use a crimp and seal splice sleeve instead of a Splice Clip. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. Page 4576 Page 5812 Release the tabs that are holding the wiredress cover to the connector body. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the slots on both ends of the connector body. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. J 38125-216 can also be used to remove the nose piece. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by lifting the terminal retaining tabs on the inside of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 2837 A wheel alignment will generally NOT correct vehicles that follow the road crown since this is within "Normal Operation." Mileage Policy The following mileage policy applies for E2020 and E2000 labor operations: Note Wheel Alignment is NOT covered under the New Vehicle Limited Warranty for Express and Savana Cutaway vehicles as these vehicles require Upfitters to set the wheel alignment after completing the vehicles. - 0-800 km (0-500 mi): E2000/E2020 claims ONLY allowed with Call Center Authorization. Due to the tie down during shipping, the vehicle's suspension requires some time to reach normal operating position. For this reason, new vehicles are generally NOT to be aligned until they have accumulated at least 800 km (500 mi). A field product report should accompany any claim within this mileage range. - 801-12,000 km (501-7,500 mi): - If a vehicle came from the factory with incorrect alignment settings, any resulting off-angle steering wheel, lead/pull characteristics or the rare occurrence of excessive tire wear would be apparent early in the life of the vehicle. The following policy applies: - Vehicles 100% Factory Set/Measured for Caster/Camber/Toe - Escalade/ESV/EXT, Tahoe/Suburban, Yukon/XL/Denali, Silverado/Sierra, Express/Savana, Corvette and Colorado/Canyon: E2000/E2020 Claims: Call Center Authorization Required - All Vehicles NOT 100% Factory Set/Measured for Caster/Camber/Toe as noted above: E2000/E2020 Claims: Dealer Service Manager Authorization Required - 12,001 km and beyond (7,501 miles and beyond): During this period, customers are responsible for the wheel alignment expense or dealers may provide on a case-by case basis a one-time customer enthusiasm claim up to 16,000 km (10,000 mi). In the event that a defective component required the use of the subject labor operations, the identified defective component labor operation will include the appropriate labor time for a wheel alignment as an add condition to the component repair. Important Only one wheel alignment labor operation claim (E2000 or E2020) may be used per VIN. Warranty Documentation Requirements When a wheel alignment service has been deemed necessary, the following items will need to be clearly documented on/with the repair order: - Customer concern in detail - What corrected the customer concern? - If a wheel alignment is performed: - Consult SI for proper specifications. - Document the "Before" AND "After" wheel alignment measurements/settings. - Completed "Wheel Alignment Repair Order Questionnaire" (form attached to this bulletin) 1. Document the customer concern in as much detail as possible on the repair order and in the warranty administration system. Preferred examples: - Steering wheel is off angle in the counterclockwise direction by approximately x degrees or clocking position. - Vehicle lead/pulls to the right at approximately x-y mph. Vehicle will climb the road crown. Severe, Moderate or Slight. - RF and LF tires are wearing on the outside shoulders with severe feathering. Important In the event of a lead/pull or steering wheel angle concern, please note the direction of lead/pull (left or right) or direction of steering wheel angle (clockwise or counterclockwise) on the repair order and within the warranty claim verbatim. Important In the event of a tire wear concern, please note the position on the vehicle and where the wear is occurring on the tire; i.e., the RF tire is wearing on the inside shoulder. 2. Document the technician's findings on cause and correction of the issue. Examples: - Reset LF toe from 0.45 degrees to 0.10 degrees and RF toe from -0.25 degrees to 0.10 degrees to correct the steering wheel angle from 5 degrees counterclockwise to 0 degrees. - Reset LF camber from 0.25 degrees to -0.05 degrees to correct the cross-camber condition of +0.30 degrees to 0.00 degrees on the vehicle. - Front Sum toe was found to be 0.50 degrees, reset to 0.20 degrees. 3. Print-out the "Before" and "After" wheel alignment measurements/settings and attach them to the Repair Order or if print-out capability is not Page 8170 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully raise the TPA on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA cannot be removed from the connector while there are terminals present in the connector body. View of the TPA when removed from the connector body. 4. Use the J 38125-12A tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the left side of the terminal release cavity as shown in the graphic. Use the tool to move the terminal release to the right with a gentle prying motion. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 4344 3. Radiator outlet hose (lower hose) to engine (3). (Shown as viewed from below.) 4. Radiator outlet hose (lower hose) to radiator (4). (Shown as viewed from below.) 5. Heater inlet hose to engine (5). Page 8138 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. 4. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front of the connector. Page 2289 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches, and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original. - The wires insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the possibility of fuel contact. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1). 5. Select the proper duraseal splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool. Refer to the Crimp and Seal Splice Table. 6. Place the duraseal splice sleeve in the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115) crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 7. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to hold the duraseal splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 8. Insert the wires into the duraseal splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel in order to prevent the wire from passing through the splice (3). 9. Close the handles of the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115), until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is applied to the splice sleeve. 10. Shrink the insulation around the splice. - Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. - Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Splicing Inline Harness Diodes SPLICING INLINE HARNESS DIODES Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure. 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode. 2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool. 5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode. Diagram Information and Instructions Door Module: Diagram Information and Instructions Electrical Symbols Locations Air Injection Control Valve Relay: Locations Fuse Block - Underhood (5.3L/6.0L), Label Page 5078 5. Engage the sliding latch fastening the BCM to the rear electrical center. Slide the latch outboard until the locking tab (1) is fully seated. 6. Install the rear electrical center cover. 7. If replacing the body wiring harness extension on a Chevrolet TrailBlazer or GMC Envoy, position the left hand second seat to a passenger position. 8. If replacing the body wiring harness extension on a Chevrolet TrailBlazer EXT or GMC Envoy XL, install the left second row seat. 9. Connect the negative battery cable. Page 1737 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Ensure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the Terminal Removal Procedure. Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PULL TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL If the terminal is visibly damaged or is suspected of having a faulty connection, the terminal should be replaced. Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors: 1. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) device and/or the secondary lock. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component or separate the connectors for in-line connectors. 3. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device. 4. Insert the proper pick or removal tool into the front of the connector body. 5. IMPORTANT: On connectors with more than one terminal the service loop may not be large enough to remove the terminal and crimp on a new one. If the terminal wire does not have a large enough service loop for removal, cut the wire 5 cm (2 in) behind the connector before removal. Grasp the wire at the back of the connector body and gently push the terminal out the front of the connector body. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. If the wire needed to be cut in order to remove the terminal, gently push a small length of the same size wire through the back of the connector cavity until there is enough wire exposed in order to crimp on a new terminal. If the wire was not cut, cut the existing wire as close to the old terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 4. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. TERMINAL INSTALLATION 1. Align the terminal and pull the wire from the back of the connector in order to seat the terminal. 2. If necessary, cut the new wire to proper length and splice with existing circuit. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. 3. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply dielectric grease to the connector. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PUSH TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Diagram Information and Instructions Knock Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions Electrical Symbols Page 4302 Spark Plug: Application and ID Spark Plug Type.............................................................................................................................................GM P/N 12571164 AC Spark Plug P/N 41-985 Page 8149 - Yazaki has a wedge or arrow shape, similar to that shown. Delphi Connectors (Micro .64) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro 64 connectors. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. The lever lock may be located on the top or sides of the wire dress cover. Page 781 Engine Control Module (ECM) C3 (Pin 16 To 59) Page 414 3. Remove the dress cover by using a flat-blade tool to release the connector locking tabs and pulling off the dress cover. 4. Relieve the tension on the nose piece retainers by inserting J-38125-12A (12094429) into the single retainer slot on the end of the nose piece and gently prying out the locking tab. Repeat the process for both of the nose piece locking tabs on the opposite side of the nose piece. Page 5295 - A control module from another vehicle is installed. - Revised software/calibration files have been released for this vehicle. - IMPORTANT: DO NOT re-program the control module with the SAME software/calibration files that are already present in the control module. This is not an effective repair for any type of concern. Verify that the control module contains the correct software/calibration. If incorrect programming is found, reprogram the control module with the most current software/calibration. Refer to Control Module References for replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Testing for Short to Ground TESTING FOR SHORT TO GROUND NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 4. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit. With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is a short to ground in the circuit. Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2. Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). - When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. - If the DMM does not display voltage 4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is shorted. Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A DIGITAL MULTIMETER NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the powertrain control module (PCM), should only be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200 Digital Multimeter (DMM). The J 39200 instruction manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminage even though voltage is present. The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity. IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading. Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the measurement. Page 7273 results from the alteration or modification of a vehicle using non-GM approved parts or accessories. Dealers should be especially cautious of accessory companies that claim the installation of their product will not void the factory warranty. Many times these companies have even given direction on how to quickly disassemble the accessory in an attempt to preclude the manufacturer from finding out that is has been installed. Any suspect repairs should be reviewed by the Fixed Operations Manager (FOM), and in Canada by the Warranty Manager (WM) for appropriate repair direction. If it is decided that a goodwill repair is to be made on the vehicle, even with the installation of such non-GM approved components, the customer is to be made aware of General Motors position on this issue and is to sign the appropriate goodwill documentation required by General Motors. It is imperative for dealers to understand that by installing such devices, they are jeopardizing not only the warranty coverage, but also the performance and reliability of the customer's vehicle. Disclaimer Page 3783 3. Ensure that the terminal release tang access panel is in the correct location to access the terminals. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) into the terminal release tang access slot located behind the access panel of the connector and press down on the terminal while carefully pulling the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Tyco/AMP Connectors (0.25 Cap) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (025 CAP) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component by pressing down on the connector position assurance (CPA). Mechanical Specifications Engine Oil: Mechanical Specifications Lubrication System Oil Capacity - with Filter ....................................................................................................................... ............................................ 5.68 liters 6.0 quarts Oil Capacity - without Filter .............................................................................................................................................................. 5.20 liters 5.5 quarts Page 3333 Fuse Block - Rear, Label Usage Page 2565 It is very important to use the correct test adapter when testing for proper terminal contact of fuses and relays in a bussed electrical center (BEC). Use J-35616-35 to test for proper terminal contact. Failure to use J-35616-35 can result in improper diagnosis of the BEC. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Separate the connector halves. 2. Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body. 3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J-38125 , test that the retention force is significantly different between a good terminal and a suspect terminal. Replace the female terminal in question. FLAT WIRE (DOCK AND LOCK) CONNECTORS There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock) connectors on the harness side or the component side. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Remove the component in question. 2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side of the connector as oil from your skin may be a source of contamination as well. 3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other imperfections that could cause poor terminal contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are uniform and free of damage or deformation. 4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the on the flat wire harness connector in order to test the circuit in question. CONTROL MODULE/COMPONENT VOLTAGE AND GROUNDS Poor voltage or ground connections can cause widely varying symptoms. Test all control module voltage supply circuits. Many vehicles have multiple circuits supplying voltage to a control module. Other components in the system may have separate voltage supply circuits that may also need to be tested. Inspect connections at the module/component connectors, fuses, and any intermediate connections between the voltage source and the module/component. A test lamp or a DMM may indicate that voltage is present, but neither tests the ability of the circuit to carry sufficient current. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Power Distribution Schematics. - Test all control module ground and system ground circuits. The control module may have multiple ground circuits. Other components in the system may have separate grounds that may also need to be tested. Inspect grounds for clean and tight connections at the grounding point. Inspect the connections at the component and in splice packs, where applicable. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Ground Distribution Schematics. TEMPERATURE SENSITIVITY - An intermittent condition may occur when a component/connection reaches normal operating temperature. The condition may occur only when the component/connection is cold, or only when the component/connection is hot. - Freeze Frame, Failure Records, Snapshot, or Vehicle Data Recorder data may help with this type of intermittent condition, where applicable. - If the intermittent is related to heat, review the data for a relationship with the following: High ambient temperatures - Underhood/engine generated heat - Circuit generated heat due to a poor connection, or high electrical load - Higher than normal load conditions, towing, etc. - If the intermittent is related to cold, review the data for the following: Low ambient temperatures-In extremely low temperatures, ice may form in a connection or component. Inspect for water intrusion. - The condition only occurs on a cold start. - The condition goes away when the vehicle warms up. - Information from the customer may help to determine if the trouble follows a pattern that is temperature related. - If temperature is suspected of causing an intermittent fault condition, attempt to duplicate the condition. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required. ELECTROMAGNETIC INTERFERENCE (EMI) AND ELECTRICAL NOISE Some electrical components/circuits are sensitive to electromagnetic interference (EMI) or other types of electrical noise. Inspect for the following conditions: A misrouted harness that is too close to high voltage/high current devices such as secondary ignition components, motors, generator etc-These components may induce electrical noise on a circuit that could interfere with normal circuit operation. - Electrical system interference caused by a malfunctioning relay, or a control module driven solenoid or switch-These conditions can cause a sharp electrical surge. Normally, the condition will occur when the malfunctioning component is operating. - Improper installation of non-factory or aftermarket add on accessories such as lights, 2-way radios, amplifiers, electric motors, remote starters, alarm systems, cell phones, etc-These accessories may lead to interference while in use, but do not fail when the accessories are not in use. - Test for an open diode across the A/C compressor clutch and for other open diodes. Some relays may contain a clamping diode. - The generator may be allowing AC noise into the electrical system. INCORRECT CONTROL MODULE - There are only a few situations where reprogramming a control module is appropriate: A new service control module is installed. Locations Power Seat Switch: Locations Driver Seat Switches (With RPO Code AR9) Page 5315 View of a typical Micro 64 connector. Depress the lock and pull the lever over and past the lock. Page 4361 Utility/Van Zoning UTILITY/VAN ZONING Page 7466 Page 7349 Connector Anatomy Connector Repairs contains a list of all connector repairs. The connector repairs are listed by the connector manufacturer and then by connector type. If the technician cannot identify the manufacturer of the connector, refer to Identifying Connectors below. Knowing the connector manufacturer will assist in finding the correct connector repair from the following list: - Connector Position Assurance Locks - Terminal Position Assurance Locks - Bosch Connectors (0.64) Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) Bosch Connectors (BSK) Bosch Connectors (ECM) - Delphi Connectors (Micro.64) Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) Delphi Connectors (12-Way) - Tyco/AMP Connectors (CM 42-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) Tyco/AMP Connectors (025 Cap) Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) - Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) - Repairing Connector Terminals IDENTIFYING CONNECTORS Knowing the connector manufacturer is helpful when trying to locating the correct connector repair procedure. There are many different connector designs used on GM vehicles and it is sometimes difficult to identify the connector manufacturer. The information in this document should help with the identification of connector manufactures. The following connector manufacturers make most of the connectors found in GM vehicles: AFL/EPC (Alcoa Fujikura Ltd./Engineered Plastics Components) - Bosch - Delphi - FCI (Framatome Connectors International) - JAE (Japan Aviation Electronics) - JST (Japan Solderless Terminals) Page 845 View of the connector when released from the component. View of another type of Micro 64 connector. Page 7146 All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system. Page 3623 Acceptably Prepared (Cleaned-Up) Wheel Surface 6. Once the corrosion has been eliminated, you should coat the repaired area with a commercially available tire sealant such as Patch Brand Bead Sealant or equivalent. Commercially available bead sealants are black rubber-like coatings that will permanently fill and seal the resurfaced bead seat. At 21°C (70°F) ambient temperature, this sealant will set-up sufficiently for tire mounting in about 10 minutes.Coated and Sealed Bead Seat 7. Remount the tire and install the repaired wheel and tire assembly. Refer to Tire and Wheel Removal and Installation in SI. Parts Information Patch Brand Bead Sealer is available from Myers Tires at 1-800-998-9897 or on the web at www.myerstiresupply.com. The one-quart size can of sealer will repair about 20 wheels. Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use: Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table above. Page 9080 2. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully push the terminal position assurance (TPA) towards the face of the connector on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA is fragile and may break if not done carefully. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. 3. Use the J 38125-215 tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 4447 Open the harness by removing any tape. 2. Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. 3. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 4. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent american wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 5. Slide a section of high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing down the length of wire to be spliced. Ensure that the shrink tubing will not interfere with the splice procedure. 6. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 7. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. 8. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 9. Insert the wire into the DuraSeal splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 10. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Page 5413 IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals. Front probe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the connector. IMPORTANT: When probing female 0.64 terminals, it is important to use the correct adapter. There have been some revisions to the test adapter for 0.64 terminals. The proper adapter for 0.64 terminals is the J 35616-64B which has a gold terminal and a black wire between the base and tip. Failure to use the proper test adapter may result in damage to the terminal being tested and improper diagnosis. NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Page 4806 View of the connector when released from the component. View of another type of Micro 64 connector. Page 5004 Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under the 5 year / 100,000 mile (160,000 km) emission warranty, use: Warranty Information (Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 514 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully raise the TPA on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA cannot be removed from the connector while there are terminals present in the connector body. View of the TPA when removed from the connector body. 4. Use the J 38125-12A tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the left side of the terminal release cavity as shown in the graphic. Use the tool to move the terminal release to the right with a gentle prying motion. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 6137 6. Gently pry the plastic terminal retainer down and carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (16-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, pull the two connector halves apart. Page 5151 Checking Aftermarket Accessories CHECKING AFTERMARKET ACCESSORIES Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits: - CAUTION: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol. - NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice. OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol. Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the cause of the problems. Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include: Power feeds connected to points other than the battery - Antenna location - Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring - Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line - Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories. Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions INDUCING INTERMITTENT FAULT CONDITIONS TOOLS REQUIRED J 25070 Heat Gun Many intermittent open or shorted circuits are affected by harness/connector movement that is caused by vibration, engine torque, bumps/rough pavement, etc. In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness if the malfunction appears to be Page 6113 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Kostal Connectors KOSTAL CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 726 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. JST Connectors JST CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, remove the connector from the component. Page 5359 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert a small flat-blade tool in the slot below the front loaded terminal position assurance (TPA) and pry up. 3. Remove the TPA by pulling it out of the connector. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-553 (GM P/N 15315247) on a slight upward angle into the cavity below the terminal to be removed. Ensure that the pointed on the end of the tool is facing the bottom of the terminal and it stays in contact with the terminal until it stops on the plastic terminal retainer. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 2102 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (BSK) BOSCH CONNECTORS (BSK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 3. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 4. Insert the J 38125-561 tool into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 5. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is Page 8091 8. If replacement of the ECM/TCM bracket is required, remove the TCM. 9. Remove the ECM/TCM bracket retaining bolts (2). 10 Remove the ECM/TCM bracket (1) from the vehicle frame. Installation Procedure 1. If the ECM/TCM bracket (1) was previously removed, install the ECM/TCM bracket (1) to the vehicle frame. 2. Install the ECM/TCM bracket retaining bolts (2). Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 3. Tighten the ECM/TCM bracket bolts. Tighten the bolts to 10 N.m (89 lb in). 4. Install the TCM. Page 8778 MEASURING FREQUENCY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal. IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM to autorange to an appropriate range. 1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency measured. Measuring Voltage MEASURING VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit. 1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods: - Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. - Turn ON the engine. - Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls. - Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested. 3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The DMM displays the voltage measured at that point. Measuring Voltage Drop MEASURING VOLTAGE DROP NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points. Probing Electrical Connectors PROBING ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS Locations Compressor Clutch Relay: Locations Fuse Block - Underhood (5.3L/6.0L), Label Page 2042 Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size. REPAIRING A FUSIBLE LINK IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient overload protection. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. Flat Wire Repairs FLAT WIRE REPAIRS NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced. GMLAN Wiring Repairs GMLAN WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The GM Local Area Network (GMLAN) System requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working on GMLAN connectors and terminals. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items in order to repair the GMLAN wiring: Dura Seal splice sleeves - A wire stripping tool - J 38125-8 Crimping Tool (GM P/N 12085115) - J 38125-5 Ultra Torch Special Tool (GM P/N 12085116) The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. - A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors GMLAN REPAIRS IMPORTANT: When making a repair to any GMLAN network, the original wire length after the repair must be the same length as before the repair. If the network is a twisted pair, the twist must be maintained after the repair is completed. GMLAN has 2 types of networks, low speed and high speed. Low speed GMLAN has a single wire and works at slow speeds. High speed GMLAN has 2 wires in a twisted pair and works at higher speeds. For more information on GMLAN, refer to Data Link Communications Description and Operation. GMLAN CONNECTOR TERMINAL REPAIR IMPORTANT: A service terminal can be used to replace damaged connector terminals for both high speed and low speed GMLAN systems. When making a connector terminal repair on a GMLAN high speed system with twisted pair wires, do not untwist the wires more than necessary to make the repair. The terminals in the GMLAN system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are available in the J-38125. If the individual terminals are damaged on any GMLAN connection, use the appropriate connector repair procedure in order to repair the terminal. GMLAN WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 4183 14. Perform the following steps in order to connect the fuel injector electrical connectors. 1. Install the connectors to their corresponding injectors to ensure correct reassembly. 2. Connect the fuel injector electrical connector. 3. Push the CPA retainer (2) on the connector in one click. 4. Repeat the steps for each injector electrical connector. 15. Install the electrical harness clips to the fuel rail. 16. Connect the A/C compressor pressure switch electrical connector (2). 17. Install the harness clip (1) to the cylinder head. Page 1999 2. Locate the nose piece locking tabs that are positioned on the side of the connector nose piece. The connector nose piece acts as a terminal positive assurance (TPA) and may be referred to as such. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to push in one of the locking tabs while gently pulling on the same side of the nose piece. 4. Repeat the procedure for the other locking tab and remove the nose piece. 5. Remove the wire dress cover. The following is a general procedure for wire dress cover removal. Use this procedure as a guide, some dress cover removal procedures may vary. 6. Use fingers to squeeze the 2 locking legs of the cover. Page 3438 11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the solder equipment. 12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. 13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to cover the first piece of tape. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE SLEEVES TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit IMPORTANT: Use only dura seal splice sleeves. Other splice sleeves may not protect the splice from moisture or provide a good electrical connection. Use duraseal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. Use duraseal splice sleeves where there is special requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire using duraseal splice sleeves. Page 5569 4. Use a small flat-blade tool to slide the terminal position assurance (TPA) up one notch on both ends of the connector. The TPA is located underneath the wire dress cover. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 2329 5. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove TPA from the connector. 6. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Page 9044 TERMINAL REMOVAL Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors. 1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA) device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1). 3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 4. Gently pull the cable and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector. 5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal, refer to Terminal Repair. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3. Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector. REINSTALLING TERMINAL 1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly, refer to Wiring Repairs. 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3. Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) DELPHI CONNECTORS (WEATHER PACK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 724 REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. The release tab is located on the top of the wiredress cover. View of connector in released position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Page 7998 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (BSK) BOSCH CONNECTORS (BSK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 3. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 4. Insert the J 38125-561 tool into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 5. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is Page 8263 - Yazaki has a wedge or arrow shape, similar to that shown. Delphi Connectors (Micro .64) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro 64 connectors. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. The lever lock may be located on the top or sides of the wire dress cover. Page 5226 View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. 4. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers CIRCUIT PROTECTION - CIRCUIT BREAKERS A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types of circuit Page 4400 2. Locate the nose piece locking tabs that are positioned on the side of the connector nose piece. The connector nose piece acts as a terminal positive assurance (TPA) and may be referred to as such. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to push in one of the locking tabs while gently pulling on the same side of the nose piece. 4. Repeat the procedure for the other locking tab and remove the nose piece. 5. Remove the wire dress cover. The following is a general procedure for wire dress cover removal. Use this procedure as a guide, some dress cover removal procedures may vary. 6. Use fingers to squeeze the 2 locking legs of the cover. Page 6919 4. Use a small flat-blade tool to slide the terminal position assurance (TPA) up one notch on both ends of the connector. The TPA is located underneath the wire dress cover. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Diagram Information and Instructions Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions Electrical Symbols Page 6030 Page 2850 Alignment: Description and Operation Setback Description Setback Description Setback applies to both the front and the rear wheels. Setback is the amount that one wheel may be aligned behind the other wheel. Setback may be the result of a road hazard or a collision. The first clue is a caster difference from side-to-side of more than 1 degree. Page 1573 Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested: - Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. - Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a component or to other harnesses. - If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A TEST LAMP TOOLS REQUIRED J 35616-200 Test Light - Probe Kit NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminate even though voltage is present. The J 35616-200 is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair of leads. To properly operate this tool use the following procedures. When testing for voltage: 1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested. When testing for ground: 1. Attach one lead to battery positive voltage. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where ground should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is ground at the point being tested. Using Connector Test Adapters USING CONNECTOR TEST ADAPTERS NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Using Fused Jumper Wires USING FUSED JUMPER WIRES TOOLS REQUIRED J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged. The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested. AFL/ECP Connectors AFL/EPC CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 2249 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully raise the TPA on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA cannot be removed from the connector while there are terminals present in the connector body. View of the TPA when removed from the connector body. 4. Use the J 38125-12A tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the left side of the terminal release cavity as shown in the graphic. Use the tool to move the terminal release to the right with a gentle prying motion. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 7253 Page 1829 Page 8214 Page 2292 US English/Metric Conversion US English/Metric Conversion Page 1876 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Ensure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the Terminal Removal Procedure. Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PULL TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL If the terminal is visibly damaged or is suspected of having a faulty connection, the terminal should be replaced. Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors: 1. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) device and/or the secondary lock. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component or separate the connectors for in-line connectors. 3. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device. 4. Insert the proper pick or removal tool into the front of the connector body. 5. IMPORTANT: On connectors with more than one terminal the service loop may not be large enough to remove the terminal and crimp on a new one. If the terminal wire does not have a large enough service loop for removal, cut the wire 5 cm (2 in) behind the connector before removal. Grasp the wire at the back of the connector body and gently push the terminal out the front of the connector body. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. If the wire needed to be cut in order to remove the terminal, gently push a small length of the same size wire through the back of the connector cavity until there is enough wire exposed in order to crimp on a new terminal. If the wire was not cut, cut the existing wire as close to the old terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 4. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. TERMINAL INSTALLATION 1. Align the terminal and pull the wire from the back of the connector in order to seat the terminal. 2. If necessary, cut the new wire to proper length and splice with existing circuit. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. 3. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply dielectric grease to the connector. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PUSH TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 7313 Engine Control Module: Locations Engine Controls Component Views Engine Control Module (ECM) 1 - Engine Control Module (ECM) 2 - Engine Control Module (ECM) C3 3 - Engine Control Module (ECM) C2 4 - Engine Control Module (ECM) C1 Page 774 Engine Control Module: Connector Views Engine Control Module Connector End Views Engine Control Module (ECM) C1 Page 8776 Checking Aftermarket Accessories CHECKING AFTERMARKET ACCESSORIES Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits: - CAUTION: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol. - NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice. OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol. Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the cause of the problems. Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include: Power feeds connected to points other than the battery - Antenna location - Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring - Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line - Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories. Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions INDUCING INTERMITTENT FAULT CONDITIONS TOOLS REQUIRED J 25070 Heat Gun Many intermittent open or shorted circuits are affected by harness/connector movement that is caused by vibration, engine torque, bumps/rough pavement, etc. In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness if the malfunction appears to be Page 2035 Release the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the blue locking tabs on both ends of the connector. Gently slide the TPA up to the released position on both ends. 6. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-13A (GM P/N 12031876-1) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. Page 8922 4. Once the front 2 locks are unlocked, lift the front of the dress cover and pull it forward. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the small slot on the TPA and pushing down until the TPA releases. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to angle or rock the J 38125-21 tool when inserting it into the connector or the tool may break. Insert the J 38125-21 (GM P/N 15381651-2) tool into the round canal between the terminals cavities at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to repair Micro 64 connector terminals. The Micro 64 connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-64 (M jaw) was developed to crimp Micro 64 terminals. The J 38125-64 crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. The J 38125-64 crimping tool is also designed to crimp both the wire and the insulation at the same time. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro 64 terminals. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. 1. Cut the wire as close to the damaged terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. Page 1349 TERMINAL REMOVAL Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors. 1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA) device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1). 3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 4. Gently pull the cable and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector. 5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal, refer to Terminal Repair. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3. Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector. REINSTALLING TERMINAL 1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly, refer to Wiring Repairs. 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3. Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) DELPHI CONNECTORS (WEATHER PACK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 746 6. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by pressing on the tang. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (SENSOR) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) tool into the cavity on the lower right hand face of the connector until the terminal release tang access panel slides over. Page 3805 6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias. Reference the appropriate service manual wiring schematic to obtain the correct diode installation position. 7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for the soldering equipment. 8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed. 9. IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode attachment points with tape. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape. Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable SPLICING TWISTED OR SHIELDED CABLE Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable. 1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splice is made. 3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire. Staggering the splices by 65 mm (2.5 in) is recommended. 4. IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical contact with the drain wire. Re-assemble the cable. Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape. - Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1). - Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire. - Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape. Page 2557 Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Page 6750 Page 1035 Front Passenger Door Module (FPDM) Service and Repair Oil Change Reminder Lamp: Service and Repair ENGINE OIL LIFE SYSTEM WHEN TO CHANGE ENGINE OIL Your vehicle has a computer system that lets you know when to change the engine oil and filter. This is based on engine revolutions and engine temperature, and not on mileage. Based on driving conditions, the mileage at which an oil change will be indicated can vary considerably. For the oil life system to work properly, you must reset the system every time the oil is changed. When the system has calculated that oil life has been diminished, it will indicate that an oil change is necessary. A change engine oil light will come on, and if your vehicle has a Driver Information Center (DIC) a "CHANGE ENGINE OIL" message will come. Change your oil as soon as possible within the next 600 miles (1 000 km). It is possible that, if you are driving under the best conditions, the oil life system may not indicate that an oil change is necessary for over a year. However, the engine oil and filter must be changed at least once a year and at this time the system must be reset. It is also important to check the oil regularly and keep it at the proper level. If the system is ever reset accidentally, you must change your oil at 3,000 miles (5 000 km) since the last oil change. Remember to reset the oil life system whenever the oil is changed. HOW TO RESET THE ENGINE OIL LIFE SYSTEM The Engine Oil Life System calculates when to change your engine oil and filter based on vehicle use. Anytime your oil is changed, reset the system so it can calculate when the next oil change is required. If a situation occurs where you change your oil prior to a "CHANGE ENGINE OIL" message being turned on, reset the system. To reset the Engine Oil Life System, do the following: If your vehicle does not have the optional Driver Information Center (DIC), do the following: 1. Turn the ignition key to "RUN" with the engine off. 2. Fully press and release the accelerator pedal slowly three times within five seconds. 3. Turn the key to "LOCK". If the message comes back on when you start the vehicle, the engine oil life system has not reset. Repeat the procedure. WHAT TO DO WITH USED OIL Used engine oil contains certain elements that may be unhealthy for your skin and could even cause cancer. Do not let used oil stay on your skin for very long. Clean your skin and nails with soap and water, or a good hand cleaner. Wash or properly dispose of clothing or rags containing used engine oil. See the manufacturer's warnings about the use and disposal of oil products. Used oil can be a threat to the environment. If you change your own oil, be sure to drain all the oil from the filter before disposal. Never dispose of oil by putting it in the trash, pouring it on the ground, into sewers, or into streams or bodies of water. Instead, recycle it by taking it to a place that collects used oil. If you have a problem properly disposing of your used oil, ask your dealer, a service station, or a local recycling center for help. Page 2418 Page 1213 Important: Never reuse the old seal or a fuel leak may occur. Always use a NEW seal. 1. Install a NEW seal (3) onto the fuel tank. Important: Place the fuel pump strainer in a horizontal position when you install the fuel sender in the tank. When installing the fuel sender assembly, assure that the fuel pump strainer does not block full travel of the float arm. 2. Install the fuel sender assembly (2). Important: Always replace the fuel sender seal when installing the fuel sender assembly. Replace the lock ring if necessary. Do not apply any type of lubrication in the seal groove. Ensure the lock ring is installed with the correct side facing upward. A correctly installed lock ring will only turn in a clockwise direction. 3. Use the J45722 in order to install the fuel sender lock ring. Turn the fuel sender lock ring in a clockwise direction. Body Wiring Harness Extension Replacement Body Control Module: Service and Repair Body Wiring Harness Extension Replacement BODY WIRING HARNESS EXTENSION REPLACEMENT - BCM REMOVAL PROCEDURE IMPORTANT: The ignition switch should be in the OFF position when connecting or disconnecting the connectors to the body control module (BCM). - Always disconnect the 40-way body wiring extension FIRST, the 32-way tan connector SECOND and the 24-way gray electrical connector LAST. - Always connect the 24-way gray electrical connector FIRST, the 32-way tan connector SECOND and the 40-way body wiring extension LAST. - The BCM can set DTCs with the ignition switch in the OFF position. The BCM has battery run down protection for the courtesy lamp circuit. The BCM battery run down protection cannot detect shorts on inputs or other circuits which the BCM does not control. Use the scan tool in order to activate the POWER DOWN NOW mode. Use the POWER DOWN NOW mode in order to check for current draws on circuits that are not controlled by the BCM, or controlled by the battery run down protection system. - Do not touch the exposed electrical contacts of the body wiring extension. 1. CAUTION: Refer to Battery Disconnect Caution. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. If replacing the body wiring harness extension on a Chevrolet Trail Blazer EXT or GMC Envoy XL, remove the left second row seat. 3. If replacing the body wiring harness extension on a Chevrolet TrailBlazer or GMC Envoy, position the left hand second seat to a cargo position. 4. Remove the rear electrical center cover. 5. Press down and hold the locking tab (1). 6. Disengage the sliding latch retaining the BCM to the rear electrical center.Slide the latch inboard until fully extended, approximately 40 mm (1.6 in). 7. Disconnect the body wiring extension (1) from the BCM. Page 1835 All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system. Page 2338 - Most Molex connectors will have the Molex logo on the dresscover of the connector. In some cases the connectors may have MX followed by another letter. The third letter indicates where the connector was made. A connector with MXD is a Molex connector made in Detroit. Sumitomo has a unique symbol on their connector and possibly a part number. The symbol is similar to that of a diamond lying on its side, similar to that shown. The logo could appear anywhere but the most common place is at the wire side of the housing. Tyco/AMP has many different and unique connector designs. Some may or may not have identifiable marks on them. Page 4305 Spark Plug: Service and Repair Spark Plug Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Remove the spark plug wire. 2. Remove the washer solvent container to gain access to the #2 spark plug. 3. Loosen the spark plug 1-2 turns. 4. Brush or using compressed air, blow away any dirt from around the spark plug. 5. Remove the spark plug. If removing more than one plug, place each plug in a tray marked with the corresponding cylinder number. Installation Procedure Page 7152 MEASURING FREQUENCY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal. IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM to autorange to an appropriate range. 1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency measured. Measuring Voltage MEASURING VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit. 1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods: - Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. - Turn ON the engine. - Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls. - Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested. 3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The DMM displays the voltage measured at that point. Measuring Voltage Drop MEASURING VOLTAGE DROP NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points. Probing Electrical Connectors PROBING ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS Page 7183 The first connector design of the Micro-Pack 100W (1) has a white connector interface that holds the terminals. The second design of the Micro-Pack 100W (2) has a gray interface to hold the terminals. Also, the first design has terminal cavities that are further apart (3 mm centerline) and offset from the other row of terminal cavities in the connector. The second design has terminals cavities that are closer together (2.54 mm centerline) and aligned vertically. One other way to identify the second design is the thin strip of material that runs along the outside of the cavities. IMPORTANT: There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W terminals which are very similar. Ensure that you have the correct terminal before crimping the new terminal to the wire. The first design connector uses the longer terminal (1) that has a raised area in front of the recess in the terminal. The second design connector uses the shorter terminal without the raised area. Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro-Pack 100W connectors. Some Micro-Pack 100W connector disassembly procedures will vary. Use this procedure as a guide. 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 3161 For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 5296 Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested: - Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. - Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a component or to other harnesses. - If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A TEST LAMP TOOLS REQUIRED J 35616-200 Test Light - Probe Kit NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminate even though voltage is present. The J 35616-200 is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair of leads. To properly operate this tool use the following procedures. When testing for voltage: 1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested. When testing for ground: 1. Attach one lead to battery positive voltage. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where ground should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is ground at the point being tested. Using Connector Test Adapters USING CONNECTOR TEST ADAPTERS NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Using Fused Jumper Wires USING FUSED JUMPER WIRES TOOLS REQUIRED J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged. The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested. AFL/ECP Connectors AFL/EPC CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 7629 - JST connectors have JST in small letters on their connectors, similar to that above. The location of the logo will vary with the connector size and style. - Kostel has an "LK" with a circle around it. These connector are usually used as a transmissions connection and are currently use on some Cadillac vehicles. Page 4974 11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the solder equipment. 12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. 13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to cover the first piece of tape. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE SLEEVES TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit IMPORTANT: Use only dura seal splice sleeves. Other splice sleeves may not protect the splice from moisture or provide a good electrical connection. Use duraseal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. Use duraseal splice sleeves where there is special requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire using duraseal splice sleeves. Page 7033 Connector Anatomy Connector Repairs contains a list of all connector repairs. The connector repairs are listed by the connector manufacturer and then by connector type. If the technician cannot identify the manufacturer of the connector, refer to Identifying Connectors below. Knowing the connector manufacturer will assist in finding the correct connector repair from the following list: - Connector Position Assurance Locks - Terminal Position Assurance Locks - Bosch Connectors (0.64) Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) Bosch Connectors (BSK) Bosch Connectors (ECM) - Delphi Connectors (Micro.64) Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) Delphi Connectors (12-Way) - Tyco/AMP Connectors (CM 42-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) Tyco/AMP Connectors (025 Cap) Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) - Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) - Repairing Connector Terminals IDENTIFYING CONNECTORS Knowing the connector manufacturer is helpful when trying to locating the correct connector repair procedure. There are many different connector designs used on GM vehicles and it is sometimes difficult to identify the connector manufacturer. The information in this document should help with the identification of connector manufactures. The following connector manufacturers make most of the connectors found in GM vehicles: AFL/EPC (Alcoa Fujikura Ltd./Engineered Plastics Components) - Bosch - Delphi - FCI (Framatome Connectors International) - JAE (Japan Aviation Electronics) - JST (Japan Solderless Terminals) Page 5440 Depress the locks that are located on both sides of the wiredress cover and pull the lever over and past the locks. View of the connector when released from the component. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the front of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool push down on one of the locking tabs and pull the cover up until the dress cover releases. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. Page 8260 - In some cases Delphi will actually be printed on the connector. If Delphi is not printed on the connector, look for PED. In both cases there is no specific orientation for Delphi or PED and they can appear anywhere on the connector. - FCI connectors may have the FCI logo on their connectors. The logo is the letters FCI with an "A" above it. - JAE connector have JAE in small letters on their connectors. Page 1949 1. If reinstalling the old sensor, coat the threads with anti-seize compound GM P/N 12377953, or equivalent. Notice: Refer to Component Fastener Tightening Notice. 2. Install the HO2S (2). Tighten the sensor to 42 N.m (31 lb ft). 3. Connect the HO2S electrical connector (1). 4. Install the CPA retainer. 5. Lower the vehicle. Page 2243 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the TPA. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the nose piece. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. Page 8169 2. Locate the two indents of the terminal position assurance (TPA) located on the bottom of the connector body. Page 870 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. 4. Remove the dress cover by using a flat bladed tool to release the dress cover locking tabs and lift up on the dress cover. 5. Cut the tie wrap that holds the wires to the connector body. Page 6579 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry one side of the nose piece up to the pre-stage position. When the nose piece is in the pre-staged position, the nose piece will be raised above the connector body the length of the step in the nose piece. 7. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry the other side of the piece to the pre-stage position. If the nose piece is higher than the first step in the nose piece, gently push down on the nose piece until it meets with resistance from the connector body, you should feel the nose piece click into position. Page 4914 - Yazaki has a wedge or arrow shape, similar to that shown. Delphi Connectors (Micro .64) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro 64 connectors. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. The lever lock may be located on the top or sides of the wire dress cover. Page 5170 6. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs located on the opposite side of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover at the connector end and pry up. 7. Remove the dress cover. 8. Cut the tie wrap on the wire bundle. 9. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting a small flat-bladed tool into the small slot in the end of the slider and pushing on the TPA until it comes out of the connector. When the TPA exits the opposite side of the connector, gasp the TPA and pull it completely out of the connector. 10. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 2162 2. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully push the terminal position assurance (TPA) towards the face of the connector on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA is fragile and may break if not done carefully. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. 3. Use the J 38125-215 tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 8006 Connector Anatomy Connector Repairs contains a list of all connector repairs. The connector repairs are listed by the connector manufacturer and then by connector type. If the technician cannot identify the manufacturer of the connector, refer to Identifying Connectors below. Knowing the connector manufacturer will assist in finding the correct connector repair from the following list: - Connector Position Assurance Locks - Terminal Position Assurance Locks - Bosch Connectors (0.64) Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) Bosch Connectors (BSK) Bosch Connectors (ECM) - Delphi Connectors (Micro.64) Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) Delphi Connectors (12-Way) - Tyco/AMP Connectors (CM 42-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) Tyco/AMP Connectors (025 Cap) Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) - Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) - Repairing Connector Terminals IDENTIFYING CONNECTORS Knowing the connector manufacturer is helpful when trying to locating the correct connector repair procedure. There are many different connector designs used on GM vehicles and it is sometimes difficult to identify the connector manufacturer. The information in this document should help with the identification of connector manufactures. The following connector manufacturers make most of the connectors found in GM vehicles: AFL/EPC (Alcoa Fujikura Ltd./Engineered Plastics Components) - Bosch - Delphi - FCI (Framatome Connectors International) - JAE (Japan Aviation Electronics) - JST (Japan Solderless Terminals) Page 4715 For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 8008 - In some cases Delphi will actually be printed on the connector. If Delphi is not printed on the connector, look for PED. In both cases there is no specific orientation for Delphi or PED and they can appear anywhere on the connector. - FCI connectors may have the FCI logo on their connectors. The logo is the letters FCI with an "A" above it. - JAE connector have JAE in small letters on their connectors. Page 2018 MOLEX CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. 2. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. Page 7733 Oil Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Engine Oil Pressure Sensor and/or Switch Replacement Tools Required J 41712 Oil Pressure Switch Socket Removal Procedure 1. Remove the intake manifold. Refer to Intake Manifold Replacement. 2. Disconnect the oil pressure sensor electrical connector (1). 3. Using J 41712 or equivalent, remove the oil pressure sensor. Installation Procedure Page 8864 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches, and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original. - The wires insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the possibility of fuel contact. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1). 5. Select the proper duraseal splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool. Refer to the Crimp and Seal Splice Table. 6. Place the duraseal splice sleeve in the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115) crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 7. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to hold the duraseal splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 8. Insert the wires into the duraseal splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel in order to prevent the wire from passing through the splice (3). 9. Close the handles of the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115), until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is applied to the splice sleeve. 10. Shrink the insulation around the splice. - Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. - Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Splicing Inline Harness Diodes SPLICING INLINE HARNESS DIODES Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure. 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode. 2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool. 5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode. Page 8397 Connector Anatomy Connector Repairs contains a list of all connector repairs. The connector repairs are listed by the connector manufacturer and then by connector type. If the technician cannot identify the manufacturer of the connector, refer to Identifying Connectors below. Knowing the connector manufacturer will assist in finding the correct connector repair from the following list: - Connector Position Assurance Locks - Terminal Position Assurance Locks - Bosch Connectors (0.64) Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) Bosch Connectors (BSK) Bosch Connectors (ECM) - Delphi Connectors (Micro.64) Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) Delphi Connectors (12-Way) - Tyco/AMP Connectors (CM 42-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) Tyco/AMP Connectors (025 Cap) Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) - Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) - Repairing Connector Terminals IDENTIFYING CONNECTORS Knowing the connector manufacturer is helpful when trying to locating the correct connector repair procedure. There are many different connector designs used on GM vehicles and it is sometimes difficult to identify the connector manufacturer. The information in this document should help with the identification of connector manufactures. The following connector manufacturers make most of the connectors found in GM vehicles: AFL/EPC (Alcoa Fujikura Ltd./Engineered Plastics Components) - Bosch - Delphi - FCI (Framatome Connectors International) - JAE (Japan Aviation Electronics) - JST (Japan Solderless Terminals) Specifications Timing Chain: Specifications Install the timing chain tensioner (232) and bolts (231). Tighten the timing chain tensioner bolts to ............................................................................................................................................ 25 N.m (18 lb ft). Important: ^ The sprocket teeth and timing chain must mesh. ^ The camshaft and the crankshaft sprocket alignment marks MUST be aligned properly. Install the camshaft sprocket (205), timing chain (208), and bolt (206). Page 1404 Page 677 Engine Control Module: Diagnostic Aids Arrows and Symbols Arrows and Symbols This Service Data uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations. Arrows and Symbols 1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow Basic Knowledge Required GENERAL ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures contained in the service manual. You should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current (amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram, as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. Decimal and Metric Equivalents Decimal and Metric Equivalents Page 6674 5. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove TPA from the connector. 6. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Page 8036 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the rear TPA from the connector. 7. IMPORTANT: The front TPA cannot be removed from the connector. Only move it to the release point. Use a small flat-blade tool to move the front TPA to the release position. 8. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 9. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Molex Connectors Page 2282 Open the harness by removing any tape. 2. Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. 3. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 4. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent american wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 5. Slide a section of high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing down the length of wire to be spliced. Ensure that the shrink tubing will not interfere with the splice procedure. 6. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 7. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. 8. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 9. Insert the wire into the DuraSeal splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 10. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Page 8858 11. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 12. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 13. Center the high temperature SCT1 shrink tube over the DuraSeal splice sleeve. 14. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the high temperature heat shrink tubing. 15. Gradually move the heat from the center to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 16. Replace any reflective tape and clips that may have been remove during the repair. Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation REPAIRING DAMAGED WIRE INSULATION Wire Size Conversion Page 5002 20. Extract a portion of the ECT sensor harness wiring and connector from the protective conduit. Cut off the ECT sensor harness connector and wiring. 21. Determine a routing path for the ECT sensor jumper harness wires so that they can be secured TO or WITHIN an existing protective conduit. Note This step is to set up and verify the length of wiring that is required before cutting. 22. Route the ECT sensor jumper wires and then enclose them in their own protective conduit in order to VERIFY the length that is required. 23. Cut the ECT sensor jumper wires to the appropriate length. Note Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splice or connector. 24. Splice the ECT sensor jumper wires to the ORIGINAL ECT HARNESS LOCATION using DuraSeal weatherproof splices. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves in SI. Note Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splice or connector. 25. Splice the ECT sensor jumper wires to the ECT SENSOR HARNESS CONNECTOR using DuraSeal weatherproof splices. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves in SI. 26. Connect the ECT sensor harness connector to the ECT sensor. 27. Secure the ECT sensor jumper wires that are in their own protective conduit TO or WITHIN the existing harness conduit using tie straps. Important You MUST run the engine at the specified RPM and until it reaches normal operating temperature and then allow it to idle as indicated in SI. The engine MUST then be allowed to cool down in order to top off the coolant level as needed. 28. Fill the cooling system to the proper level. Refer to Cooling System Draining and Filling in SI. 29. Pressure test the cooling system. Refer to Cooling System Leak Testing in SI. 30. Use a scan tool to clear any DTCs. Relocating the Engine Coolant Heater Cord Important For reference, the procedure and graphics that are shown are from a Chevrolet Silverado, but are similar for the other vehicles listed above. 1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Ask the customer where they would prefer the extension cord to exit from the engine compartment in order to determine the required extension cord length. 3. Obtain an extension cord with the following features: - 120 volt - 14/3 gauge - 15A capacity - Three prong - Polarized plug and receptacle - Chemical resistant - Grounded terminals - Designed for use in a cold outdoor environment - Outer jacket resistant to deterioration from moisture, abrasion and exposure to sunlight - Maximum length of 2.5-3 m (8-10 ft) 4. Release enough of the clips that retain the engine coolant heater cord to the vehicle to provide the necessary length for repositioning. 5. Apply dielectric grease to the electrical contacts of the heater cord receptacle and the extension cord plug to prevent corrosion. Use GM P/N 12345579 (in Canada, use P/N 10953481) or an equivalent. 6. Connect the heater cord receptacle to the extension cord plug and wipe OFF any excess grease. Page 8888 Throttle Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids Arrows and Symbols Arrows and Symbols This Service Data uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations. Arrows and Symbols 1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow Basic Knowledge Required GENERAL ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures contained in the service manual. You should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current (amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram, as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. Decimal and Metric Equivalents Decimal and Metric Equivalents Page 6299 Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Page 1882 Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. FCI Connectors FCI CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 5928 Page 3604 Some customers may use penetrating oils, grease or other lubricants on wheel studs to aid in removal or installation. Always use a suitable cleaner/solvent to remove these lubricants prior to installing the wheel and tire assemblies. Lubricants left on the wheel studs may cause improper readings of wheel nut torque. Always install wheels to clean, dry wheel studs ONLY. Notice Lubricants left on the wheel studs or vertical mounting surfaces between the wheel and the rotor or drum may cause the wheel to work itself loose after the vehicle is driven. Always install wheels to clean, dry wheel studs and surfaces ONLY. Beginning with 2011 model year vehicles, put a light coating of grease, GM P/N 1051344 (in Canada, P/N 9930370), on the inner surface of the wheel pilot hole to prevent wheel seizure to the axle or bearing hub. Wheel Stud and Lug Nut Damage Always inspect the wheel studs and lug nuts for signs of damage from crossthreading or abuse. You should never have to force wheel nuts down the stud. Lug nuts that are damaged may not retain properly, yet give the impression of fully tightening. Always inspect and replace any component suspected of damage. Tip Always start wheel nuts by hand! Be certain that all wheel nut threads have been engaged BEFORE tightening the nut. Important If the vehicle has directional tread tires, verify the directional arrow on the outboard side of the tire is pointing in the direction of forward rotation. Wheel Nut Tightening and Torque Improper wheel nut tightening can lead to brake pulsation and rotor damage. In order to avoid additional brake repairs, evenly tighten the wheel nuts to the proper torque specification as shown for each vehicle in SI. Always observe the proper wheel nut tightening sequence as shown below in order to avoid trapping the wheel on the wheel stud threads or clamping the wheel slightly off center resulting in vibration. The Most Important Service You Provide While the above information is well known, and wheel removal so common, technicians run the risk of becoming complacent on this very important Page 6194 It is very important to use the correct test adapter when testing for proper terminal contact of fuses and relays in a bussed electrical center (BEC). Use J-35616-35 to test for proper terminal contact. Failure to use J-35616-35 can result in improper diagnosis of the BEC. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Separate the connector halves. 2. Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body. 3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J-38125 , test that the retention force is significantly different between a good terminal and a suspect terminal. Replace the female terminal in question. FLAT WIRE (DOCK AND LOCK) CONNECTORS There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock) connectors on the harness side or the component side. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Remove the component in question. 2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side of the connector as oil from your skin may be a source of contamination as well. 3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other imperfections that could cause poor terminal contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are uniform and free of damage or deformation. 4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the on the flat wire harness connector in order to test the circuit in question. CONTROL MODULE/COMPONENT VOLTAGE AND GROUNDS Poor voltage or ground connections can cause widely varying symptoms. Test all control module voltage supply circuits. Many vehicles have multiple circuits supplying voltage to a control module. Other components in the system may have separate voltage supply circuits that may also need to be tested. Inspect connections at the module/component connectors, fuses, and any intermediate connections between the voltage source and the module/component. A test lamp or a DMM may indicate that voltage is present, but neither tests the ability of the circuit to carry sufficient current. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Power Distribution Schematics. - Test all control module ground and system ground circuits. The control module may have multiple ground circuits. Other components in the system may have separate grounds that may also need to be tested. Inspect grounds for clean and tight connections at the grounding point. Inspect the connections at the component and in splice packs, where applicable. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Ground Distribution Schematics. TEMPERATURE SENSITIVITY - An intermittent condition may occur when a component/connection reaches normal operating temperature. The condition may occur only when the component/connection is cold, or only when the component/connection is hot. - Freeze Frame, Failure Records, Snapshot, or Vehicle Data Recorder data may help with this type of intermittent condition, where applicable. - If the intermittent is related to heat, review the data for a relationship with the following: High ambient temperatures - Underhood/engine generated heat - Circuit generated heat due to a poor connection, or high electrical load - Higher than normal load conditions, towing, etc. - If the intermittent is related to cold, review the data for the following: Low ambient temperatures-In extremely low temperatures, ice may form in a connection or component. Inspect for water intrusion. - The condition only occurs on a cold start. - The condition goes away when the vehicle warms up. - Information from the customer may help to determine if the trouble follows a pattern that is temperature related. - If temperature is suspected of causing an intermittent fault condition, attempt to duplicate the condition. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required. ELECTROMAGNETIC INTERFERENCE (EMI) AND ELECTRICAL NOISE Some electrical components/circuits are sensitive to electromagnetic interference (EMI) or other types of electrical noise. Inspect for the following conditions: A misrouted harness that is too close to high voltage/high current devices such as secondary ignition components, motors, generator etc-These components may induce electrical noise on a circuit that could interfere with normal circuit operation. - Electrical system interference caused by a malfunctioning relay, or a control module driven solenoid or switch-These conditions can cause a sharp electrical surge. Normally, the condition will occur when the malfunctioning component is operating. - Improper installation of non-factory or aftermarket add on accessories such as lights, 2-way radios, amplifiers, electric motors, remote starters, alarm systems, cell phones, etc-These accessories may lead to interference while in use, but do not fail when the accessories are not in use. - Test for an open diode across the A/C compressor clutch and for other open diodes. Some relays may contain a clamping diode. - The generator may be allowing AC noise into the electrical system. INCORRECT CONTROL MODULE - There are only a few situations where reprogramming a control module is appropriate: A new service control module is installed. Page 7384 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 7190 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) and slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. Page 8902 3. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. View showing depressing of the lever lock release tab. Page 2422 Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids Arrows and Symbols Arrows and Symbols This Service Data uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations. Arrows and Symbols 1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow Basic Knowledge Required GENERAL ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures contained in the service manual. You should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current (amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram, as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. Decimal and Metric Equivalents Decimal and Metric Equivalents Page 3727 3. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. View showing depressing of the lever lock release tab. Page 172 Utility/Van Zoning UTILITY/VAN ZONING Page 8728 If a wire is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm, etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except coaxial. - Do not use the DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent American wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 672 Page 4838 9. The illustration shows a cutaway view of the connector to aid the technician in releasing the terminal retainer. 10. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Terminal Position Assurance Locks TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Tyco/Amp Connectors (CM 42-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (CM 42-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the connector body and pull the CPA out. The CPA is on the wire harness side of connector. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 2623 4. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the rear of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. 5. Once the locking tabs are unlocked, slide the inner connector out of the rear of the connector housing. Page 4976 6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias. Reference the appropriate service manual wiring schematic to obtain the correct diode installation position. 7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for the soldering equipment. 8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed. 9. IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode attachment points with tape. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape. Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable SPLICING TWISTED OR SHIELDED CABLE Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable. 1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splice is made. 3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire. Staggering the splices by 65 mm (2.5 in) is recommended. 4. IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical contact with the drain wire. Re-assemble the cable. Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape. - Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1). - Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire. - Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape. Page 5235 If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the DuraSeal splice sleeves. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: - Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. - Do not use the crimp and DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 to crimp DuraSeal splice sleeve. In order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 6190 IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals. Front probe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the connector. IMPORTANT: When probing female 0.64 terminals, it is important to use the correct adapter. There have been some revisions to the test adapter for 0.64 terminals. The proper adapter for 0.64 terminals is the J 35616-64B which has a gold terminal and a black wire between the base and tip. Failure to use the proper test adapter may result in damage to the terminal being tested and improper diagnosis. NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Page 9001 Utility/Van Zoning UTILITY/VAN ZONING Page 3187 Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Contaminated R134A Refrigerant Bulletin No.: 06-01-39-007 Date: July 25, 2006 INFORMATION Subject: Contaminated R134a Refrigerant Found on Market for Automotive Air-Conditioning Systems Models: 2007 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2007 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2007 and Prior Saab 9-7X Attention: This bulletin should be directed to the Service Manager as well as the Parts Manager. Commercially Available Contaminated R134a Refrigerant Impurities have been found in new commercially available containers of R134a. High levels of contaminates may cause decreased performance, and be detrimental to some air-conditioning components. Accompanying these contaminates has been high levels of moisture. Tip: Excessive moisture may cause system concerns such as orifice tube freeze-up and reduced performance. Industry Reaction: New Industry Purity Standards Due to the potential availability of these lower quality refrigerants, the Society of Automotive Engineers (SAE), and the Air Conditioning and Refrigeration Industry (ARI) are in the process of instituting reliable standards that will be carried on the labels of future R134a refrigerant containers. This identifying symbol will be your assurance of a product that conforms to the minimum standard for OEM Automotive Air-Conditioning use. How Can You Protect Yourself Today? It is recommended to use GM or ACDelco(R) sourced refrigerants for all A/C repair work. These refrigerants meet General Motors own internal standards for quality and purity, insuring that your completed repairs are as good as the way it left the factory. Parts Information The part numbers shown are available through GMSPO or ACDelco(R). The nearest ACDelco(R) distributor in your area can be found by calling 1-800-223-3526 (U.S. Only). Page 1701 vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide variety of actions, including: - Wiggling the harness - Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting - Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector - Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation - Relocating a harness or wires All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. Another option is, with the component commanded ON and OFF by the scan tool, move related connectors and wiring and observe the component operation. With the engine running, move related connectors and wiring while monitoring engine operation. If harness or connector movement affects the data displayed, component/system operation, or engine operation, inspect and repair the harness/connections as necessary. You may need to load the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these cases you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide good results as well. There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions, along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the circuit to these kinds of conditions. SALT WATER SPRAY Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture. Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5 percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously. HIGH TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070. Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault condition. The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis. This option does not allow for the same control, however. LOW TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect. If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to -18°C (0°F) from one end and +71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized cooling needs. Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or components in an effort to duplicate the concern. DUPLICATING FAILURE CONDITIONS - If none of the previous tests are successful, attempt to duplicate and/or capture the failure conditions. Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, where applicable, contains the conditions that were present when the DTC set. 1. Review and record Freeze Frame/Failure Records data. 2. Clear the DTCs using the scan tool. 3. Turn the key to OFF and wait 15 seconds. 4. Operate the vehicle under the same conditions that were noted in Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, as closely as possible. The vehicle must also be operating within the Conditions for Running the DTC. Refer to Conditions for Running the DTC in the supporting text if a DTC is being diagnosed. 5. Monitor DTC Status for the DTC being tested. The scan tool will indicate Ran, when the enabling conditions have been satisfied long enough for the DTC to run. The scan tool will also indicate whether the DTC passed or failed. - An alternate method is to drive the vehicle with the DMM connected to a suspected circuit. An abnormal reading on the DMM when the concern occurs, may help you locate the concern. Measuring Frequency Page 8721 View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. View of the release tool being used for the smaller terminals. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (2-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 4595 Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. For connectors with a bolt in the dress cover, turn the bolt counterclockwise to remove the connector from the component. 2. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. Page 6297 Throttle Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids Arrows and Symbols Arrows and Symbols This Service Data uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations. Arrows and Symbols 1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow Basic Knowledge Required GENERAL ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures contained in the service manual. You should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current (amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram, as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. Decimal and Metric Equivalents Decimal and Metric Equivalents Page 4848 View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. View of the release tool being used for the smaller terminals. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (2-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 8442 3. Ensure that the terminal release tang access panel is in the correct location to access the terminals. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) into the terminal release tang access slot located behind the access panel of the connector and press down on the terminal while carefully pulling the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Tyco/AMP Connectors (0.25 Cap) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (025 CAP) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component by pressing down on the connector position assurance (CPA). Page 5988 View of typical connector. View of connector in released position. 1. Locate the assist lever at the back of the connector. Move the assist lever to the rear position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the dress cover. Page 7668 2. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 6249 3. Use a small flat-bladed tool to gently pry off the dress cover by inserting the tool under the cover opposite the harness side and prying up. 4. Remove the cover. 5. Using a small flat-bladed tool, push on the side of the nose piece retainer while pushing the nose piece forward with your thumb. This will release the terminal position assurance (TPA). 6. Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) into the corresponding terminal release cavity. The release cavities are the 2 center rows of cavities on one half of the connector. Page 2405 Page 8834 3. Remove the dress cover by using a flat-blade tool to release the connector locking tabs and pulling off the dress cover. 4. Relieve the tension on the nose piece retainers by inserting J-38125-12A (12094429) into the single retainer slot on the end of the nose piece and gently prying out the locking tab. Repeat the process for both of the nose piece locking tabs on the opposite side of the nose piece. Page 6768 1. Ignition OFF, relieve the fuel pressure. Refer to Fuel Pressure Relief. 2. Install the J37287 between the fuel feed pipe and the fuel rail. 3. Open the valve on the J37287. 4. Ignition ON, command the fuel pump relay ON with a scan tool and bleed the air from the fuel pressure gage. 5. Close the valve on the J37287. 6. Verify that the fuel pressure does not decrease more than 34 kPa (5 psi) in 1 minute. ‹› If the fuel pressure drops, locate and replace the leaking fuel injector. 7. If the fuel system test normal, replace the fuel pump. * Relieve the fuel pressure to 69 kPa (10 psi). Verify that the fuel pressure does not decrease more than 14 kPa (2 psi) in 5 minutes. ‹› If the fuel pressure decreases more than the specified value, replace the fuel pump. * Remove the J37287 and J34730-1A. * Operate the vehicle within the conditions of the customers concern while monitoring the fuel trim and O2 parameters with a scan tool. The scan tool parameters should not indicate a lean condition. ‹› If the scan tool parameters indicate a lean condition, test for a restricted fuel feed pipe, restricted fuel filter, or poor connections at the harness connectors and ground circuits of the fuel pump. If all test normal, replace the fuel pump. * If the fuel system components test normal, refer to Symptoms - Engine Controls. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures/Symptoms - Engine Controls Repair Instructions Perform the Diagnostic Repair Verification after completing the diagnostic procedure. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests and Procedures * Fuel Injector Replacement * Fuel Sender Assembly Replacement Page 857 Release the lower wiredress cover locking tab. Release the upper wiredress cover locking tab. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. Page 267 5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape. Seat Belt Schematic Icons Seat Belt Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons Cooling System - DEX-COOL(R) Coolant Leak Detection Dye Coolant: Technical Service Bulletins Cooling System - DEX-COOL(R) Coolant Leak Detection Dye Bulletin No.: 05-06-02-002B Date: January 18, 2008 INFORMATION Subject: DEX-COOL(R) Coolant - New Leak Detection Dye J 46366 - Replaces J 29545-6 Models: 1996-2008 GM Passenger Cars and Light/Medium Duty Trucks* (including Saturn) 1997-2008 Isuzu T-Series Medium Duty Tilt Cab Models Built in Janesville and Flint 1999-2008 Isuzu N-Series Medium Duty Commercial Models with 5.7L or 6.0L Gas Engine 2003-2008 HUMMER H2 2006-2008 HUMMER H3 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X *EXCLUDING 2006 and Prior Chevrolet Aveo, Epica, Optra, Vivant and Pontiac Matiz, Wave Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to include additional model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 05-06-02-002A (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). Leak detection dye P/N 12378563 (J 29545-6) (in Canada P/N 88900915) may cause DEX-COOL(R) coolant to appear green in a black vessel making it appear to be conventional (green) coolant. This may cause a technician to add conventional coolant to a low DEX-COOL(R) system thus contaminating it. The green DEX-COOL(R) appearance is caused by the color of the leak detection dye which alters the color of the DEX-COOL(R) coolant. A new leak detection dye P/N 89022219 (J 46366) (in Canada P/N 89022220) has been released that does not alter the appearance of the DEX-COOL(R) coolant. When adding the new leak detection dye the color of the DEX-COOL(R) coolant will not change. For detecting leaks on any system that uses DEX-COOL(R) leak detection dye P/N 89022219 (in Canada P/N 89022220) should be used. The new leak detection dye can be used with both conventional and DEX-COOL(R) coolant. Disclaimer Page 2943 1. Route the drive belt around all the pulleys except the generator pulley. 2. Install the breaker bar with hex-head socket to the belt tensioner bolt. 3. Rotate the belt tensioner clockwise in order to relieve the tension on the belt. 4. Install the drive belt on the generator pulley. 5. Slowly release the tension on the belt tensioner. 6. Remove the breaker bar and socket from the belt tensioner bolt. 7. Inspect the drive belt for proper installation and alignment. 8. Install the air cleaner resonator outlet duct. Refer to Air Cleaner Resonator Outlet Duct Replacement. Page 6019 Open the harness by removing any tape. 2. Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. 3. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 4. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent american wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 5. Slide a section of high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing down the length of wire to be spliced. Ensure that the shrink tubing will not interfere with the splice procedure. 6. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 7. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. 8. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 9. Insert the wire into the DuraSeal splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 10. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Page 2107 6. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs located on the opposite side of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover at the connector end and pry up. 7. Remove the dress cover. 8. Cut the tie wrap on the wire bundle. 9. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting a small flat-bladed tool into the small slot in the end of the slider and pushing on the TPA until it comes out of the connector. When the TPA exits the opposite side of the connector, gasp the TPA and pull it completely out of the connector. 10. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 1591 - Yazaki has a wedge or arrow shape, similar to that shown. Delphi Connectors (Micro .64) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro 64 connectors. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. The lever lock may be located on the top or sides of the wire dress cover. Page 6373 6. Gently pry the plastic terminal retainer down and carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (16-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, pull the two connector halves apart. OnStar Module Bracket Assembly Replacement (Trailblazer EXT, Envoy XL) Emergency Contact Module: Service and Repair OnStar Module Bracket Assembly Replacement (Trailblazer EXT, Envoy XL) OnStar Module Bracket Assembly Replacement (Trailblazer EXT, Envoy XL) Removal Procedure 1. Fold and tumble the right rear seat to a cargo position. 2. Leaving the electrical connectors attached, remove the communication interface module from the vehicle communication interface module (VCIM) bracket. Refer to Communication Interface Module Replacement (TrailBlazer EXT, Envoy XL) Communication Interface Module Replacement (TrailBlazer, Envoy, Rainier). 3. Using a flat bladed tool, release the retaining tab (1) on the VCIM bracket. 4. Slide the VCIM bracket rearward until the retaining tabs are released from the seat bracket. 5. Remove the VCIM bracket from vehicle. 6. Slide the VCIM bracket rearward until the retaining tabs are released from the seat bracket. 7. Remove the VCIM bracket from vehicle. Installation Procedure 1. Position the VCIM bracket to the seat bracket. 2. Slide the VCIM bracket forward until the retaining tabs become locked to the seat bracket. 3. Ensure the retaining tab (1) on the VCIM bracket is properly seated. 4. Install the communication interface module. Page 1587 - Kostel - Molex - Sumitomo - Tyco/AMP - Yazaki Identifying the manufacturer of a connector is often difficult. When trying to determine the manufacturer of a connector, look for specific identifying marks that are unique to that connector supplier. Most of these identify marks are hard to find or see. Check the connector carefully and refer to the information below for pictures and descriptions of connector identification markings. - Most of AFLs connectors have EPC on their connector body. Some of the smaller connectors will not have any markings on them. - In some cases Bosch will actually be printed on the connector. If Bosch does not appear on the connector, look for the Bosch logo. The Bosch logo is a circle with a blunted arrow inside. This logo can appear anywhere on the connector and is often very small. Page 6197 Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. For connectors with a bolt in the dress cover, turn the bolt counterclockwise to remove the connector from the component. 2. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. Page 5956 IMPORTANT: Ensure that the dress cover and connector body are both in the released position before reassembling. Failure to do so may cause damage to the connector and component. Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (0.64) BOSCH CONNECTORS (0.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While pressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock until the lever is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Pull the rubber boot that covers the wires back to expose the end of the connector dress cover. 4. Place the connector locking lever in the center of the connector. 5. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs that are on the wire end of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover and connector body and pry up. Page 5939 vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide variety of actions, including: - Wiggling the harness - Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting - Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector - Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation - Relocating a harness or wires All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. Another option is, with the component commanded ON and OFF by the scan tool, move related connectors and wiring and observe the component operation. With the engine running, move related connectors and wiring while monitoring engine operation. If harness or connector movement affects the data displayed, component/system operation, or engine operation, inspect and repair the harness/connections as necessary. You may need to load the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these cases you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide good results as well. There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions, along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the circuit to these kinds of conditions. SALT WATER SPRAY Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture. Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5 percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously. HIGH TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070. Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault condition. The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis. This option does not allow for the same control, however. LOW TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect. If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to -18°C (0°F) from one end and +71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized cooling needs. Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or components in an effort to duplicate the concern. DUPLICATING FAILURE CONDITIONS - If none of the previous tests are successful, attempt to duplicate and/or capture the failure conditions. Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, where applicable, contains the conditions that were present when the DTC set. 1. Review and record Freeze Frame/Failure Records data. 2. Clear the DTCs using the scan tool. 3. Turn the key to OFF and wait 15 seconds. 4. Operate the vehicle under the same conditions that were noted in Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, as closely as possible. The vehicle must also be operating within the Conditions for Running the DTC. Refer to Conditions for Running the DTC in the supporting text if a DTC is being diagnosed. 5. Monitor DTC Status for the DTC being tested. The scan tool will indicate Ran, when the enabling conditions have been satisfied long enough for the DTC to run. The scan tool will also indicate whether the DTC passed or failed. - An alternate method is to drive the vehicle with the DMM connected to a suspected circuit. An abnormal reading on the DMM when the concern occurs, may help you locate the concern. Measuring Frequency Page 6248 9. The illustration shows a cutaway view of the connector to aid the technician in releasing the terminal retainer. 10. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Terminal Position Assurance Locks TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Tyco/Amp Connectors (CM 42-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (CM 42-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the connector body and pull the CPA out. The CPA is on the wire harness side of connector. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 7080 5. While pushing the terminal forward, insert the J 38125-24 in the release cavity above the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (43-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Page 1199 Parts required to complete this service update are to be obtained from Saab Parts Distribution Center (PDC). Service Procedure Tools Required J 45722 or equivalent 1. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle in SI. (1) Fuel Tank Label (2) fuel Tank (3) Rear Axle 2. Locate the fuel tank label (1), which is on the backside of the fuel tank (2) below the fuel tank filler neck. 3. Inspect the fuel tank for a white "X" on the fuel tank and/or a green "C" on the barcode. ^ If a white "X" on the fuel tank and/or a green "C" on the barcode is found, the fuel sender assembly does not require replacement. No further action is required. ^ If a white "X" on the fuel tank and/or a green "C" on the barcode is not found, proceed to Step 4 for additional inspection. Page 8370 Utility/Van Zoning UTILITY/VAN ZONING Page 8924 The first connector design of the Micro-Pack 100W (1) has a white connector interface that holds the terminals. The second design of the Micro-Pack 100W (2) has a gray interface to hold the terminals. Also, the first design has terminal cavities that are further apart (3 mm centerline) and offset from the other row of terminal cavities in the connector. The second design has terminals cavities that are closer together (2.54 mm centerline) and aligned vertically. One other way to identify the second design is the thin strip of material that runs along the outside of the cavities. IMPORTANT: There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W terminals which are very similar. Ensure that you have the correct terminal before crimping the new terminal to the wire. The first design connector uses the longer terminal (1) that has a raised area in front of the recess in the terminal. The second design connector uses the shorter terminal without the raised area. Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro-Pack 100W connectors. Some Micro-Pack 100W connector disassembly procedures will vary. Use this procedure as a guide. 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 1447 Connector Anatomy Connector Repairs contains a list of all connector repairs. The connector repairs are listed by the connector manufacturer and then by connector type. If the technician cannot identify the manufacturer of the connector, refer to Identifying Connectors below. Knowing the connector manufacturer will assist in finding the correct connector repair from the following list: - Connector Position Assurance Locks - Terminal Position Assurance Locks - Bosch Connectors (0.64) Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) Bosch Connectors (BSK) Bosch Connectors (ECM) - Delphi Connectors (Micro.64) Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) Delphi Connectors (12-Way) - Tyco/AMP Connectors (CM 42-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) Tyco/AMP Connectors (025 Cap) Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) - Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) - Repairing Connector Terminals IDENTIFYING CONNECTORS Knowing the connector manufacturer is helpful when trying to locating the correct connector repair procedure. There are many different connector designs used on GM vehicles and it is sometimes difficult to identify the connector manufacturer. The information in this document should help with the identification of connector manufactures. The following connector manufacturers make most of the connectors found in GM vehicles: AFL/EPC (Alcoa Fujikura Ltd./Engineered Plastics Components) - Bosch - Delphi - FCI (Framatome Connectors International) - JAE (Japan Aviation Electronics) - JST (Japan Solderless Terminals) Page 4903 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. 4. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front of the connector. Page 2398 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link). - The wire insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. 5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold them between thumb and forefinger. 7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place. - Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction. - Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip. 8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool closes.Ensure that no strands of wire are cut. 10. Crimp the splice on each end (2). Page 6876 MEASURING FREQUENCY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal. IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM to autorange to an appropriate range. 1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency measured. Measuring Voltage MEASURING VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit. 1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods: - Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. - Turn ON the engine. - Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls. - Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested. 3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The DMM displays the voltage measured at that point. Measuring Voltage Drop MEASURING VOLTAGE DROP NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points. Probing Electrical Connectors PROBING ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS Page 2112 - In some cases Delphi will actually be printed on the connector. If Delphi is not printed on the connector, look for PED. In both cases there is no specific orientation for Delphi or PED and they can appear anywhere on the connector. - FCI connectors may have the FCI logo on their connectors. The logo is the letters FCI with an "A" above it. - JAE connector have JAE in small letters on their connectors. Locations Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Locations Fuse Block - Underhood (5.3L/6.0L), Label Page 1944 Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Heated Oxygen Sensor Replacement - Bank 1 Sensor 2 Heated Oxygen Sensor Replacement - Bank 1 Sensor 2 Removal Procedure 1. Raise and suitably support the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. Notice: Refer to Heated Oxygen and Oxygen Sensor Notice. 2. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) retainer. 3. Disconnect the heated oxygen sensor (HO2S) electrical connector. Notice: Refer to Excessive Force and Oxygen Sensor Notice. 4. Remove the HO2S (2). Installation Procedure Important: A special anti-seize compound is used on the HO2S threads. The compound consists of liquid graphite and glass beads. The graphite tends to burn away, but the glass beads remain, making the sensor easier to remove. New, or service replacement sensors already have the compound applied to the threads. If the sensor is removed from an exhaust component and if for any reason the sensor is to be reinstalled, the threads must have anti-seize compound applied before the reinstallation. Page 6067 IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals. Front probe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the connector. IMPORTANT: When probing female 0.64 terminals, it is important to use the correct adapter. There have been some revisions to the test adapter for 0.64 terminals. The proper adapter for 0.64 terminals is the J 35616-64B which has a gold terminal and a black wire between the base and tip. Failure to use the proper test adapter may result in damage to the terminal being tested and improper diagnosis. NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Page 8982 US English/Metric Conversion US English/Metric Conversion Engine - Low Oil Lamp ON/Oil Leaks Oil Pressure Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Low Oil Lamp ON/Oil Leaks TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 07-06-01-004A Date: November 25, 2008 Subject: All Vortec(R) GEN IV V8 Engines - LY2 LS4 LC9 LH6 LMG LY5 LS2 L76 LY6 L92 LS7, Low Oil Level Indicator Lamp On and/or Engine Oil Leak (Reseal Oil Pressure Sensor) Models Supercede: This bulletin is being updated to include a labor operation number for CTS-V and Corvette models. Please discard Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 07-06-01-004 (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System). Condition Some customers may comment on a low oil level indicator lamp on and/or engine oil leak. Upon further investigation, the technician may find that the oil leak is at the oil pressure sensor that is threaded into the valve lifter oil manifold (VLOM) assembly and/or engine valley cover. Correction If the engine oil leak was found to be at the engine oil pressure sensor, then remove the oil pressure sensor and reseal with a pipe sealant with Teflon or equivalent, P/N 12346004 (in Canada, P/N 10953480). Refer to Engine Oil Pressure Sensor and/or Switch Replacement in SI. Parts Information Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models) Page 4843 6. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by pressing on the tang. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (SENSOR) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) tool into the cavity on the lower right hand face of the connector until the terminal release tang access panel slides over. Page 6529 to analyze the data during the time a vehicle condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a trigger point that you have determined. Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2 snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a first-in, first-out basis. If a third snapshot is taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost. Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types: Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice - Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200 frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not lost if the Scan Tool is powered down. The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis. The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected values by plotting 3 parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful, especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC. Testing for a Short to Voltage TESTING FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4. Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt, there is a short to voltage in the circuit. Testing for Continuity TESTING FOR CONTINUITY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6. Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit. 7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity. With a Test Lamp IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits. 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6. If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity. Testing for Electrical Intermittents TESTING FOR ELECTRICAL INTERMITTENTS Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment. - Testing for Short to Ground - Testing for Continuity - Testing for a Short to Voltage Page 4814 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Ensure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the Terminal Removal Procedure. Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PULL TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL If the terminal is visibly damaged or is suspected of having a faulty connection, the terminal should be replaced. Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors: 1. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) device and/or the secondary lock. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component or separate the connectors for in-line connectors. 3. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device. 4. Insert the proper pick or removal tool into the front of the connector body. 5. IMPORTANT: On connectors with more than one terminal the service loop may not be large enough to remove the terminal and crimp on a new one. If the terminal wire does not have a large enough service loop for removal, cut the wire 5 cm (2 in) behind the connector before removal. Grasp the wire at the back of the connector body and gently push the terminal out the front of the connector body. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. If the wire needed to be cut in order to remove the terminal, gently push a small length of the same size wire through the back of the connector cavity until there is enough wire exposed in order to crimp on a new terminal. If the wire was not cut, cut the existing wire as close to the old terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 4. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. TERMINAL INSTALLATION 1. Align the terminal and pull the wire from the back of the connector in order to seat the terminal. 2. If necessary, cut the new wire to proper length and splice with existing circuit. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. 3. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply dielectric grease to the connector. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PUSH TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 5282 Utility/Van Zoning UTILITY/VAN ZONING Page 2940 Step 7 - Step 13 Page 2583 - JST connectors have JST in small letters on their connectors, similar to that above. The location of the logo will vary with the connector size and style. - Kostel has an "LK" with a circle around it. These connector are usually used as a transmissions connection and are currently use on some Cadillac vehicles. Page 7238 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches, and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original. - The wires insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the possibility of fuel contact. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1). 5. Select the proper duraseal splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool. Refer to the Crimp and Seal Splice Table. 6. Place the duraseal splice sleeve in the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115) crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 7. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to hold the duraseal splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 8. Insert the wires into the duraseal splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel in order to prevent the wire from passing through the splice (3). 9. Close the handles of the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115), until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is applied to the splice sleeve. 10. Shrink the insulation around the splice. - Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. - Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Splicing Inline Harness Diodes SPLICING INLINE HARNESS DIODES Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure. 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode. 2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool. 5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode. Page 7318 Page 2995 1. Relieve the fuel system pressure, if required. Perform the following steps: Caution: Wrap a shop towel around the fuel pressure connection in order to reduce the risk of fire and personal injury. The towel will absorb any fuel leakage that occurs during the connection of the fuel pressure gage. Place the towel in an approved container when the connection of the fuel pressure gage is complete. 1. Wrap a shop towel around the fuel rail service port. 2. Place the hose on the CH-48027-2 (2) into an approved gasoline container. 3. Open the valve on the CH-48027-2 (2) in order to bleed any fuel from the fuel rail. 4. Close the valve on the CH-48027-2 (2). 5. Remove the hose on the CH-48027-2 (2) from the approved gasoline container. 6. Remove the shop towel from around the fuel rail service port, and place in an approved gasoline container. Notice: Clean all of the following areas before performing any disconnections in order to avoid possible contamination in the system: * The fuel pipe connections * The hose connections * The areas surrounding the connections Disconnect the CH-48027-1 (1) from the CH-48027-2 (2). 2. Disconnect the CH-48027-2 (2) from the CH-48027-3 (4). 3. Disconnect the CH-48027-3 (4) from the fuel rail service port. 4. Install the fuel rail service port cap. 5. Tighten the fuel fill cap. Page 4470 Utility/Van Zoning UTILITY/VAN ZONING Page 3248 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (BSK) BOSCH CONNECTORS (BSK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 3. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 4. Insert the J 38125-561 tool into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 5. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is Page 8909 IMPORTANT: Ensure that the dress cover and connector body are both in the released position before reassembling. Failure to do so may cause damage to the connector and component. Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (0.64) BOSCH CONNECTORS (0.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While pressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock until the lever is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Pull the rubber boot that covers the wires back to expose the end of the connector dress cover. 4. Place the connector locking lever in the center of the connector. 5. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs that are on the wire end of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover and connector body and pry up. Page 6210 - Kostel - Molex - Sumitomo - Tyco/AMP - Yazaki Identifying the manufacturer of a connector is often difficult. When trying to determine the manufacturer of a connector, look for specific identifying marks that are unique to that connector supplier. Most of these identify marks are hard to find or see. Check the connector carefully and refer to the information below for pictures and descriptions of connector identification markings. - Most of AFLs connectors have EPC on their connector body. Some of the smaller connectors will not have any markings on them. - In some cases Bosch will actually be printed on the connector. If Bosch does not appear on the connector, look for the Bosch logo. The Bosch logo is a circle with a blunted arrow inside. This logo can appear anywhere on the connector and is often very small. Page 3965 7. If necessary, remove the ignition coils and bracket from the rocker arm cover. 8. Remove the positive crankcase ventilation (PCV) hose from the rocker arm cover. 9. Remove the valve rocker arm cover bolts. 10. Remove the valve rocker arm cover. Page 4393 - Yazaki has a wedge or arrow shape, similar to that shown. Delphi Connectors (Micro .64) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro 64 connectors. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. The lever lock may be located on the top or sides of the wire dress cover. Page 25 * Dealers using WINs: Add 0.2 hours to the labor time for administrative allowance for the module exchange. Dealers using GWM: Submit 0.2 hours administrative allowance under "Administration Time" for the module exchange. ** The $25 represents the additional net amount allowed for the module exchange. *** Dealers are to claim only administrative allowance of 0.2 hours when the module is replaced by Masscomp's Mobile Unit. Dealers using WINS should submit the 0.2 hours administrative allowance in labor time. Dealer using GWM should submit the 0.2 hours administrative allowance under Administrative Time. Customer Notification OnStar will notify customers of this program on their vehicle. Dealer Program Responsibility All unsold new vehicles in dealers'/retailers' possession and subject to this program must be held and inspected/repaired per the service procedure of this program bulletin before customers take possession of these vehicles. Dealers/retailers are to service all vehicles subject to this program at no charge to customers, regardless of mileage, age of vehicle, or ownership, through April 30, 2011. Customers who have recently purchased vehicles sold from your vehicle inventory, and for which there is no customer information indicated on the dealer/retailer listing, are to be contacted by the dealer/retailer. Arrangements are to be made to make the required correction according to the instructions contained in this bulletin. A copy of the customer letter is provided in this bulletin for your use in contacting customers. Program follow-up cards should not be used for this purpose, since the customer may not as yet have received the notification letter. Page 2592 2. Locate the nose piece locking tabs that are positioned on the side of the connector nose piece. The connector nose piece acts as a terminal positive assurance (TPA) and may be referred to as such. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to push in one of the locking tabs while gently pulling on the same side of the nose piece. 4. Repeat the procedure for the other locking tab and remove the nose piece. 5. Remove the wire dress cover. The following is a general procedure for wire dress cover removal. Use this procedure as a guide, some dress cover removal procedures may vary. 6. Use fingers to squeeze the 2 locking legs of the cover. Locations Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Locations Engine Controls Component Views Upper Left Side of the Engine 1 - Fuel Injector 1 2 - Evaporative Emission (EVAP) Canister Purge Solenoid 3 - Fuel Injector 3 4 Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor 5 - Fuel Injector 5 6 - Fuel Injector 7 7 - Engine 8 Ignition Coil 7 9 - Ignition Coil 5 10 - Ignition Coil Harness 11 - C109 12 - Ignition Coil 3 13 - Ignition Coil 1 Page 6237 View of typical connector. View of connector in released position. 1. Locate the assist lever at the back of the connector. Move the assist lever to the rear position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the dress cover. Page 8826 View of typical connector. View of connector in released position. 1. Locate the assist lever at the back of the connector. Move the assist lever to the rear position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the dress cover. Page 8447 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert a small flat-blade tool in the slot below the front loaded terminal position assurance (TPA) and pry up. 3. Remove the TPA by pulling it out of the connector. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-553 (GM P/N 15315247) on a slight upward angle into the cavity below the terminal to be removed. Ensure that the pointed on the end of the tool is facing the bottom of the terminal and it stays in contact with the terminal until it stops on the plastic terminal retainer. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 3435 If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the DuraSeal splice sleeves. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: - Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. - Do not use the crimp and DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 to crimp DuraSeal splice sleeve. In order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 7716 Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Service and Repair Manifold Absolute Pressure Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Disconnect the manifold absolute pressure (MAP) sensor electrical connector (3). 2. Remove the MAP sensor retaining clip (2) from the intake manifold. 3. Remove the MAP sensor (1) from the intake manifold. Installation Procedure Important: Lightly coat the MAP sensor seal with clean engine oil before installing the sensor. Page 5838 The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors. 1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position. 4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool J 38125-10A (GM P/N 12014012-1) into the front (mating end) of the connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal through the back of the connector (2). IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector. 6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. 7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily. 10. Perform system check. Delphi Connectors (12 Way) DELPHI CONNECTORS (12-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. Page 5984 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. JST Connectors JST CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, remove the connector from the component. Page 8201 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Start in the middle and gradually move the heat barrel to the open ends of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Heated Oxygen Sensor Wiring Repairs HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being obstructed. If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. - Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks, etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire. - Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance. - To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector. Page 7984 Checking Aftermarket Accessories CHECKING AFTERMARKET ACCESSORIES Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits: - CAUTION: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol. - NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice. OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol. Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the cause of the problems. Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include: Power feeds connected to points other than the battery - Antenna location - Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring - Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line - Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories. Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions INDUCING INTERMITTENT FAULT CONDITIONS TOOLS REQUIRED J 25070 Heat Gun Many intermittent open or shorted circuits are affected by harness/connector movement that is caused by vibration, engine torque, bumps/rough pavement, etc. In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness if the malfunction appears to be Page 8896 to analyze the data during the time a vehicle condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a trigger point that you have determined. Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2 snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a first-in, first-out basis. If a third snapshot is taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost. Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types: Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice - Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200 frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not lost if the Scan Tool is powered down. The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis. The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected values by plotting 3 parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful, especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC. Testing for a Short to Voltage TESTING FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4. Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt, there is a short to voltage in the circuit. Testing for Continuity TESTING FOR CONTINUITY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6. Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit. 7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity. With a Test Lamp IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits. 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6. If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity. Testing for Electrical Intermittents TESTING FOR ELECTRICAL INTERMITTENTS Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment. - Testing for Short to Ground - Testing for Continuity - Testing for a Short to Voltage Page 5154 IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals. Front probe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the connector. IMPORTANT: When probing female 0.64 terminals, it is important to use the correct adapter. There have been some revisions to the test adapter for 0.64 terminals. The proper adapter for 0.64 terminals is the J 35616-64B which has a gold terminal and a black wire between the base and tip. Failure to use the proper test adapter may result in damage to the terminal being tested and improper diagnosis. NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Page 2498 6. Gently pry the plastic terminal retainer down and carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (16-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, pull the two connector halves apart. Page 4792 difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Bosch Connectors (ECM) BOSCH CONNECTORS (ECM) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the assist lever on the top of the connector. Move the assist lever to the forward position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 7695 US English/Metric Conversion US English/Metric Conversion Page 3735 6. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs located on the opposite side of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover at the connector end and pry up. 7. Remove the dress cover. 8. Cut the tie wrap on the wire bundle. 9. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting a small flat-bladed tool into the small slot in the end of the slider and pushing on the TPA until it comes out of the connector. When the TPA exits the opposite side of the connector, gasp the TPA and pull it completely out of the connector. 10. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 7590 1 - Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor 2 - Knock Sensor (KS) 2 - Right 3 - Engine Harness 4 Starter 5 - Engine Page 8563 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the rear TPA from the connector. 7. IMPORTANT: The front TPA cannot be removed from the connector. Only move it to the release point. Use a small flat-blade tool to move the front TPA to the release position. 8. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 9. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Molex Connectors Page 2084 All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system. Page 7200 View of typical connector. View of connector in released position. 1. Locate the assist lever at the back of the connector. Move the assist lever to the rear position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the dress cover. Page 8524 Release the tabs that are holding the wiredress cover to the connector body. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the slots on both ends of the connector body. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. J 38125-216 can also be used to remove the nose piece. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by lifting the terminal retaining tabs on the inside of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 7930 Note The rivet stud and surrounding panel area MUST BE properly refinished PRIOR to the installation of the electrical ground wire terminal and conductive nut to maintain a secure, stable and corrosion-free electrical ground. 11. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and Repair in SI. 12. Allow the refinished repair area to cure sufficiently before removing the protective material applied to the rivet stud threads. 13. Remove the painters tape or equivalent from the rivet stud threads. 14. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, thoroughly clean the rivet stud threads to remove any adhesive and allow to dry. 15. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M6 conductive rivet stud. Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase. 16. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground wire terminal. 17. Install the electrical ground wire terminal to the M6 conductive rivet stud. 18. Select a M6 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 19. Install the M6 conductive nut to the rivet stud and: Tighten Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb in) 20. Verify proper system operation. Parts Information Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use: Warranty Information (Saab Models) Page 6163 4. Position the tool J 41364-A onto the park/neutral position switch. Ensure that the 2 slots on the switch where the manual shaft is inserted are lined up with the lower 2 tabs on the tool. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 5. Rotate the tool until the upper locator pin on the tool is lined up with the slot on the top of the switch. Tighten the bolts securing the switch to 25 N.m (18 lb ft). 6. Remove the J 41364-A from the switch. If installing a new switch, remove the positive assurance bracket at this time. 7. Connect the electrical connectors to the switch. 8. Install the transmission control lever to the manual shaft with the nut. Tighten the control lever nut to 25 N.m (18 lb ft). 9. Lower the vehicle. 10. Check the switch for proper operation. The engine must start in the P (Park) or N (Neutral) positions only. If proper operation of the switch can not be obtained, replace the switch. Locations Dash Panel Page 8514 IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals. Front probe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the connector. IMPORTANT: When probing female 0.64 terminals, it is important to use the correct adapter. There have been some revisions to the test adapter for 0.64 terminals. The proper adapter for 0.64 terminals is the J 35616-64B which has a gold terminal and a black wire between the base and tip. Failure to use the proper test adapter may result in damage to the terminal being tested and improper diagnosis. NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Page 4947 7. The illustration above identifies the entry canal where the terminal release tool will be inserted, and the terminal cavity. - Terminal (1) - Entry Canal (2) 8. Insert the J-38125-553 (15315247) tool into the entry canal and pry up on the terminal retainer. The terminal retainer is a small plastic piece on the top of the terminal. The terminal retainer must be held up while the terminal is pulled out of the connector. Page 1870 4. Once the front 2 locks are unlocked, lift the front of the dress cover and pull it forward. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the small slot on the TPA and pushing down until the TPA releases. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to angle or rock the J 38125-21 tool when inserting it into the connector or the tool may break. Insert the J 38125-21 (GM P/N 15381651-2) tool into the round canal between the terminals cavities at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to repair Micro 64 connector terminals. The Micro 64 connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-64 (M jaw) was developed to crimp Micro 64 terminals. The J 38125-64 crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. The J 38125-64 crimping tool is also designed to crimp both the wire and the insulation at the same time. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro 64 terminals. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. 1. Cut the wire as close to the damaged terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. Page 1488 7. Pressing the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool in the release cavity of the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and crimper in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (DOOR MODULE) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Side view of connector. View of top of connector. 1. Locate the assist lever and lock on the top of the connector. Page 6702 4. Use a small flat-blade tool to slide the terminal position assurance (TPA) up one notch on both ends of the connector. The TPA is located underneath the wire dress cover. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 4755 Disclaimer Page 4614 View of the connector when released from the component. View of another type of Micro 64 connector. Page 1157 1. Apply sealant to the threads of the oil pressure sensor. Refer to Sealers, Adhesives, and Lubricants for the correct part number. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Using J 41712 or equivalent, install the oil pressure sensor. Tighten the sensor to 35 N.m (26 lb ft). 3. Connect the oil pressure sensor electrical connector (1). 4. Install the intake manifold. Refer to Intake Manifold Replacement. Page 3586 Disclaimer Specifications Timing Cover: Specifications Front Cover Bolts ................................................................................................................................. ....................................................... 25 N.m (18 lb ft) Page 5842 Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. FCI Connectors FCI CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 4520 4. Use a small flat-blade tool to slide the terminal position assurance (TPA) up one notch on both ends of the connector. The TPA is located underneath the wire dress cover. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 8144 Connector Anatomy Connector Repairs contains a list of all connector repairs. The connector repairs are listed by the connector manufacturer and then by connector type. If the technician cannot identify the manufacturer of the connector, refer to Identifying Connectors below. Knowing the connector manufacturer will assist in finding the correct connector repair from the following list: - Connector Position Assurance Locks - Terminal Position Assurance Locks - Bosch Connectors (0.64) Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) Bosch Connectors (BSK) Bosch Connectors (ECM) - Delphi Connectors (Micro.64) Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) Delphi Connectors (12-Way) - Tyco/AMP Connectors (CM 42-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) Tyco/AMP Connectors (025 Cap) Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) - Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) - Repairing Connector Terminals IDENTIFYING CONNECTORS Knowing the connector manufacturer is helpful when trying to locating the correct connector repair procedure. There are many different connector designs used on GM vehicles and it is sometimes difficult to identify the connector manufacturer. The information in this document should help with the identification of connector manufactures. The following connector manufacturers make most of the connectors found in GM vehicles: AFL/EPC (Alcoa Fujikura Ltd./Engineered Plastics Components) - Bosch - Delphi - FCI (Framatome Connectors International) - JAE (Japan Aviation Electronics) - JST (Japan Solderless Terminals) Locations Windshield Washer Switch: Locations Behind The Center Of The I/P (With RPO Code X88) Page 484 IMPORTANT: Ensure that the dress cover and connector body are both in the released position before reassembling. Failure to do so may cause damage to the connector and component. Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (0.64) BOSCH CONNECTORS (0.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While pressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock until the lever is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Pull the rubber boot that covers the wires back to expose the end of the connector dress cover. 4. Place the connector locking lever in the center of the connector. 5. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs that are on the wire end of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover and connector body and pry up. Page 8429 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. 4. Remove the dress cover by using a flat bladed tool to release the dress cover locking tabs and lift up on the dress cover. 5. Cut the tie wrap that holds the wires to the connector body. Page 8720 Release the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the blue locking tabs on both ends of the connector. Gently slide the TPA up to the released position on both ends. 6. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-13A (GM P/N 12031876-1) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. Locations Seat Belt Tension Sensor: Locations SIR Component Views Right Rear of Passenger Seat 1 - Inflatable restraint Passenger Seat Belt Tension Retractor Sensor Page 7822 View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. View of the release tool being used for the smaller terminals. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (2-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 1624 7. The illustration above identifies the entry canal where the terminal release tool will be inserted, and the terminal cavity. - Terminal (1) - Entry Canal (2) 8. Insert the J-38125-553 (15315247) tool into the entry canal and pry up on the terminal retainer. The terminal retainer is a small plastic piece on the top of the terminal. The terminal retainer must be held up while the terminal is pulled out of the connector. Page 4673 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches, and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original. - The wires insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the possibility of fuel contact. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1). 5. Select the proper duraseal splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool. Refer to the Crimp and Seal Splice Table. 6. Place the duraseal splice sleeve in the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115) crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 7. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to hold the duraseal splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 8. Insert the wires into the duraseal splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel in order to prevent the wire from passing through the splice (3). 9. Close the handles of the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115), until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is applied to the splice sleeve. 10. Shrink the insulation around the splice. - Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. - Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Splicing Inline Harness Diodes SPLICING INLINE HARNESS DIODES Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure. 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode. 2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool. 5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode. Page 776 Engine Control Module (ECM) C1 (Pin 16 To 56) Engine Control Module (ECM) C2 Page 7748 Oxygen Sensor: Diagnostic Aids Arrows and Symbols Arrows and Symbols This Service Data uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations. Arrows and Symbols 1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow Basic Knowledge Required GENERAL ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures contained in the service manual. You should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current (amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram, as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. Decimal and Metric Equivalents Decimal and Metric Equivalents Page 609 Body Control Module (BCM) C2 Page 7254 Page 8706 8. Insert the J 38125-213 into the small terminal release hole on the nose piece and gently pull on the back of the wire. 9. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Repairing Connector Terminals REPAIRING CONNECTOR TERMINALS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following: Push to Seat terminals - Pull to Seat terminals Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your terminal repair. The J-38125 contains further information. 1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.For cable seal terminals, remove the seal. 2. Apply the correct cable seal per gage size of the wire, if used.Slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation removal. 3. Remove the insulation. 4. For sealed terminals only, align the seal with the end of the cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal.For sealed terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal. 6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.For sealed terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable. 8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals excepting Micro-Pack 100.64 size. Soldering Micro-Pack 100 World terminals may damage the terminal. Sumitomo Connectors SUMITOMO CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit OnStar(R) - Analog/Digital System Information Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Analog/Digital System Information INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 06-08-46-008C Date: September 18, 2008 Subject: Information on OnStar(R) Dual-Mode (Analog/Digital) Systems Models Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to correct the model year range for the Chevrolet Impala and Monte Carlo and update the reference to GM Dealerworld. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 06-08-46-008B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories). All 2000-2003 model year vehicles equipped with OnStar® from the list above were built with Analog/Digital-Ready OnStar(R) Hardware. Some of these vehicles may have been upgraded to Dual-Mode (Analog/Digital). Certain 2004-2005 model year vehicles equipped with OnStar(R) from the list above may have been either: ^ Originally built at the factory with Dual-Mode (Analog/Digital) OnStar(R) Hardware with Dual-Mode (Analog/Digital) OnStar(R) Hardware OR ^ Upgraded to Dual-Mode (Analog/Digital) Hardware All 2006 model year and newer vehicles equipped with OnStar(R) were built at the factory with Dual-Mode (Analog/Digital) OnStar(R) Hardware. If a vehicle has Dual-Mode (Analog/Digital) OnStar(R) Hardware, then the system is capable of operating on both the analog and digital cellular Page 7784 The first connector design of the Micro-Pack 100W (1) has a white connector interface that holds the terminals. The second design of the Micro-Pack 100W (2) has a gray interface to hold the terminals. Also, the first design has terminal cavities that are further apart (3 mm centerline) and offset from the other row of terminal cavities in the connector. The second design has terminals cavities that are closer together (2.54 mm centerline) and aligned vertically. One other way to identify the second design is the thin strip of material that runs along the outside of the cavities. IMPORTANT: There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W terminals which are very similar. Ensure that you have the correct terminal before crimping the new terminal to the wire. The first design connector uses the longer terminal (1) that has a raised area in front of the recess in the terminal. The second design connector uses the shorter terminal without the raised area. Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro-Pack 100W connectors. Some Micro-Pack 100W connector disassembly procedures will vary. Use this procedure as a guide. 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 3400 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Kostal Connectors KOSTAL CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 4535 7. The illustration above identifies the entry canal where the terminal release tool will be inserted, and the terminal cavity. - Terminal (1) - Entry Canal (2) 8. Insert the J-38125-553 (15315247) tool into the entry canal and pry up on the terminal retainer. The terminal retainer is a small plastic piece on the top of the terminal. The terminal retainer must be held up while the terminal is pulled out of the connector. Page 6938 2. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 1458 The first connector design of the Micro-Pack 100W (1) has a white connector interface that holds the terminals. The second design of the Micro-Pack 100W (2) has a gray interface to hold the terminals. Also, the first design has terminal cavities that are further apart (3 mm centerline) and offset from the other row of terminal cavities in the connector. The second design has terminals cavities that are closer together (2.54 mm centerline) and aligned vertically. One other way to identify the second design is the thin strip of material that runs along the outside of the cavities. IMPORTANT: There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W terminals which are very similar. Ensure that you have the correct terminal before crimping the new terminal to the wire. The first design connector uses the longer terminal (1) that has a raised area in front of the recess in the terminal. The second design connector uses the shorter terminal without the raised area. Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro-Pack 100W connectors. Some Micro-Pack 100W connector disassembly procedures will vary. Use this procedure as a guide. 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. Locations Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Locations Park Neutral Position (PNP) Switch 1 - Automatic Transmission 4L60-E/4L65-E/4L70 2 - Park/Neutral Position (PNP) Switch Page 7036 - JST connectors have JST in small letters on their connectors, similar to that above. The location of the logo will vary with the connector size and style. - Kostel has an "LK" with a circle around it. These connector are usually used as a transmissions connection and are currently use on some Cadillac vehicles. Page 880 2. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 4881 Page 1970 to analyze the data during the time a vehicle condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a trigger point that you have determined. Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2 snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a first-in, first-out basis. If a third snapshot is taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost. Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types: Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice - Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200 frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not lost if the Scan Tool is powered down. The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis. The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected values by plotting 3 parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful, especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC. Testing for a Short to Voltage TESTING FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4. Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt, there is a short to voltage in the circuit. Testing for Continuity TESTING FOR CONTINUITY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6. Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit. 7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity. With a Test Lamp IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits. 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6. If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity. Testing for Electrical Intermittents TESTING FOR ELECTRICAL INTERMITTENTS Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment. - Testing for Short to Ground - Testing for Continuity - Testing for a Short to Voltage Page 4060 The dexos (TM) specification and trademarks are exclusive to General Motors, LLC. Only those oils displaying the dexos (TM) trademark and icon on the front label meet the demanding performance requirements and stringent quality standards set forth in the dexos (TM)specification. Look on the front label for any of the logos shown above to identify an authorized, licensed dexos 2(TM) engine oil. GM dexos 2(TM) Engine Oil Specification - dexos 2(TM) is approved and recommended by GM for use in Europe starting in model year 2010 vehicles, regardless of where the vehicle was manufactured. - dexos 2(TM) is the recommended service fill oil for European gasoline engines. Important The Duramax(TM) diesel engine is the exception and requires lubricants meeting specification CJ-4. - dexos 2(TM) is the recommended service fill oil for European light-duty diesel engines and replaces GM-LL-B-025 and GM-LL-A-025. - dexos 2(TM) protects diesel engines from harmful soot deposits and is designed with limits on certain chemical components to prolong catalyst life and protect expensive emission reduction systems. It is a robust oil, resisting degradation between oil changes and maintaining optimum performance longer. Disclaimer Page 751 View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. View of the release tool being used for the smaller terminals. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (2-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 6945 View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. View of the release tool being used for the smaller terminals. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (2-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 2577 6. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs located on the opposite side of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover at the connector end and pry up. 7. Remove the dress cover. 8. Cut the tie wrap on the wire bundle. 9. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting a small flat-bladed tool into the small slot in the end of the slider and pushing on the TPA until it comes out of the connector. When the TPA exits the opposite side of the connector, gasp the TPA and pull it completely out of the connector. 10. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 1354 Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. FCI Connectors FCI CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 952 Battery Control Module: Diagrams Starting and Charging Connector End Views Regulated Voltage Control Module Page 6488 Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size. REPAIRING A FUSIBLE LINK IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient overload protection. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. Flat Wire Repairs FLAT WIRE REPAIRS NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced. GMLAN Wiring Repairs GMLAN WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The GM Local Area Network (GMLAN) System requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working on GMLAN connectors and terminals. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items in order to repair the GMLAN wiring: Dura Seal splice sleeves - A wire stripping tool - J 38125-8 Crimping Tool (GM P/N 12085115) - J 38125-5 Ultra Torch Special Tool (GM P/N 12085116) The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. - A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors GMLAN REPAIRS IMPORTANT: When making a repair to any GMLAN network, the original wire length after the repair must be the same length as before the repair. If the network is a twisted pair, the twist must be maintained after the repair is completed. GMLAN has 2 types of networks, low speed and high speed. Low speed GMLAN has a single wire and works at slow speeds. High speed GMLAN has 2 wires in a twisted pair and works at higher speeds. For more information on GMLAN, refer to Data Link Communications Description and Operation. GMLAN CONNECTOR TERMINAL REPAIR IMPORTANT: A service terminal can be used to replace damaged connector terminals for both high speed and low speed GMLAN systems. When making a connector terminal repair on a GMLAN high speed system with twisted pair wires, do not untwist the wires more than necessary to make the repair. The terminals in the GMLAN system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are available in the J-38125. If the individual terminals are damaged on any GMLAN connection, use the appropriate connector repair procedure in order to repair the terminal. GMLAN WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 4384 IMPORTANT: Ensure that the dress cover and connector body are both in the released position before reassembling. Failure to do so may cause damage to the connector and component. Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (0.64) BOSCH CONNECTORS (0.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While pressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock until the lever is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Pull the rubber boot that covers the wires back to expose the end of the connector dress cover. 4. Place the connector locking lever in the center of the connector. 5. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs that are on the wire end of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover and connector body and pry up. Page 1961 All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system. Page 4936 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Kostal Connectors KOSTAL CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 7401 2. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully push the terminal position assurance (TPA) towards the face of the connector on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA is fragile and may break if not done carefully. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. 3. Use the J 38125-215 tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 813 Fuel Pump Relay: Diagnostic Aids Arrows and Symbols Arrows and Symbols This Service Data uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations. Arrows and Symbols 1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow Basic Knowledge Required GENERAL ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures contained in the service manual. You should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current (amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram, as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. Decimal and Metric Equivalents Decimal and Metric Equivalents Page 708 View of a typical Micro 64 connector. Depress the lock and pull the lever over and past the lock. Page 2181 Page 3484 up, allowing tire air pressure to increase above the threshold causing the light to go off. Properly adjusting all tire air pressures to the recommended levels will correct this (Refer to the Tire and Loading Information Label on the driver side door). - More detailed information can be found in the Owner Manual. - Service is not covered under warranty - this maintenance is the responsibility of the owner. - Give the customer a copy of the "GM Customer TPMS Information". For more detailed information, refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 07-03-16-004C and TPMS Training Course 13044.12T2. Tire Pressure Light At key on, without starting the vehicle: Steady Solid Glowing TPM Indicator If the TPM indicator appears as a steady glowing yellow lamp (as above), the system is functioning properly and you should add air to the tires to correct this condition. Blinking TPM Indicator If the TPM indicator appears as a BLINKING yellow lamp for one minute and then stays on solid, diagnostic service is needed. The Effect of Outside Temperature on Tire Pressures Important: As a rule of thumb, tire pressure will change about 7kPa (1 psi) for every 6°C (10°F) decrease in temperature - Tire pressure will drop when it gets colder outside, and rise when it gets warmer. Under certain situations such as extreme outside temperature changes, the system may bring on a solid light with a check tire pressure message. This should be considered normal and the system is working properly. The light will turn off upon adding the proper amount of air to the tires (refer to the Tire & Loading Information label in the driver's door opening). When properly adjusting tire air pressure, the following steps are important to help optimize the system and prolong bringing a tire pressure light on: ^ Use an accurate, high quality tire pressure gauge. ^ Never set the tire pressure below the specified placard value regardless of tire temperature or ambient temperature. ^ Tire pressure should be set to the specified placard pressure at the lowest seasonal temperature the vehicle will encounter during operation. Page 780 Engine Control Module (ECM) C3 (Pin 1 To 15) Page 6314 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (BSK) BOSCH CONNECTORS (BSK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 3. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 4. Insert the J 38125-561 tool into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 5. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is Page 93 For vehicles repaired under warranty use, the table. Disclaimer Page 1833 Page 7383 8. Insert the J 38125-213 into the small terminal release hole on the nose piece and gently pull on the back of the wire. 9. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Repairing Connector Terminals REPAIRING CONNECTOR TERMINALS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following: Push to Seat terminals - Pull to Seat terminals Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your terminal repair. The J-38125 contains further information. 1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.For cable seal terminals, remove the seal. 2. Apply the correct cable seal per gage size of the wire, if used.Slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation removal. 3. Remove the insulation. 4. For sealed terminals only, align the seal with the end of the cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal.For sealed terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal. 6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.For sealed terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable. 8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals excepting Micro-Pack 100.64 size. Soldering Micro-Pack 100 World terminals may damage the terminal. Sumitomo Connectors SUMITOMO CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 6116 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the rear TPA from the connector. 7. IMPORTANT: The front TPA cannot be removed from the connector. Only move it to the release point. Use a small flat-blade tool to move the front TPA to the release position. 8. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 9. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Molex Connectors Page 7075 2. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 6361 9. The illustration shows a cutaway view of the connector to aid the technician in releasing the terminal retainer. 10. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Terminal Position Assurance Locks TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Tyco/Amp Connectors (CM 42-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (CM 42-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the connector body and pull the CPA out. The CPA is on the wire harness side of connector. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 6429 IMPORTANT: Ensure that the dress cover and connector body are both in the released position before reassembling. Failure to do so may cause damage to the connector and component. Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (0.64) BOSCH CONNECTORS (0.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While pressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock until the lever is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Pull the rubber boot that covers the wires back to expose the end of the connector dress cover. 4. Place the connector locking lever in the center of the connector. 5. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs that are on the wire end of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover and connector body and pry up. Page 5234 If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs SIR/SRS WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS, and the wiring components, such as connectors and terminals. IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system terminals. Use either an SIR/SRS pigtail or a terminated lead from the SIR Repair Kit Tray. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves, in order to repair the SIR/SRS wiring - A special crimping tool - A heat torch - An instruction manual The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides the necessary low resistance contact integrity for these sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors SIR/SRS CONNECTOR REPAIR (PLASTIC BODY AND TERMINAL METAL PIN) The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made with a special plating. This plating provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. Use the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit for repairing SIR/SRS terminals and connectors. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the repair kit. The J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit contains: Various terminated leads for sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) terminal replacement - Various connector positive assurance (CPA) locks for SIR/SRS connectors - Base of steering column pigtail connectors part number 12085514 - Yellow vinyl electrical tape Pigtail repair packs are available for SIR/SRS connectors with eight or less terminals. Only the connector body is available for connectors with more than eight terminals. The terminated leads in the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit can be used to replace damaged terminals when replacing the connector body. SIR/SRS COMPONENT WIRE PIGTAIL REPAIR IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails. A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device, not by a connector. If a wiring pigtail is damaged, you must replace the entire component, with pigtail. The inflatable restraint steering wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component. SIR/SRS WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 5439 View of the connector when released from the component. View of another type of Micro 64 connector. Page 2500 View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. 4. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers CIRCUIT PROTECTION - CIRCUIT BREAKERS A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types of circuit Page 3388 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Ensure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the Terminal Removal Procedure. Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PULL TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL If the terminal is visibly damaged or is suspected of having a faulty connection, the terminal should be replaced. Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors: 1. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) device and/or the secondary lock. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component or separate the connectors for in-line connectors. 3. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device. 4. Insert the proper pick or removal tool into the front of the connector body. 5. IMPORTANT: On connectors with more than one terminal the service loop may not be large enough to remove the terminal and crimp on a new one. If the terminal wire does not have a large enough service loop for removal, cut the wire 5 cm (2 in) behind the connector before removal. Grasp the wire at the back of the connector body and gently push the terminal out the front of the connector body. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. If the wire needed to be cut in order to remove the terminal, gently push a small length of the same size wire through the back of the connector cavity until there is enough wire exposed in order to crimp on a new terminal. If the wire was not cut, cut the existing wire as close to the old terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 4. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. TERMINAL INSTALLATION 1. Align the terminal and pull the wire from the back of the connector in order to seat the terminal. 2. If necessary, cut the new wire to proper length and splice with existing circuit. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. 3. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply dielectric grease to the connector. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PUSH TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Input Speed Sensor (ISS) Harness Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagrams Input Speed Sensor (ISS) Harness Input Speed Sensor (ISS) Harness Input Speed Sensor (ISS) Harness Page 7639 7. Apply pressure and gently rock the cover until one locking leg is unseated. 8. Continue to apply pressure and rock the cover until the second locking leg is unseated. Repeat procedure for the other side of the dress cover and remove the cover. 9. Use J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) to gently lift the terminal retaining tab while gently pulling the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 10. If the terminal is severely bent or damaged, it may be possible on some connectors to push the wire out of the front of the connector instead of Page 1641 Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size. REPAIRING A FUSIBLE LINK IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient overload protection. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. Flat Wire Repairs FLAT WIRE REPAIRS NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced. GMLAN Wiring Repairs GMLAN WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The GM Local Area Network (GMLAN) System requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working on GMLAN connectors and terminals. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items in order to repair the GMLAN wiring: Dura Seal splice sleeves - A wire stripping tool - J 38125-8 Crimping Tool (GM P/N 12085115) - J 38125-5 Ultra Torch Special Tool (GM P/N 12085116) The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. - A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors GMLAN REPAIRS IMPORTANT: When making a repair to any GMLAN network, the original wire length after the repair must be the same length as before the repair. If the network is a twisted pair, the twist must be maintained after the repair is completed. GMLAN has 2 types of networks, low speed and high speed. Low speed GMLAN has a single wire and works at slow speeds. High speed GMLAN has 2 wires in a twisted pair and works at higher speeds. For more information on GMLAN, refer to Data Link Communications Description and Operation. GMLAN CONNECTOR TERMINAL REPAIR IMPORTANT: A service terminal can be used to replace damaged connector terminals for both high speed and low speed GMLAN systems. When making a connector terminal repair on a GMLAN high speed system with twisted pair wires, do not untwist the wires more than necessary to make the repair. The terminals in the GMLAN system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are available in the J-38125. If the individual terminals are damaged on any GMLAN connection, use the appropriate connector repair procedure in order to repair the terminal. GMLAN WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 1119 under pressure if the radiator cap or the surge tank cap is removed while the engine and radiator are still hot. 4. Remove the surge tank fill cap from the surge tank or the coolant pressure cap from the radiator. 5. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle in SI. 6. Place a clean drain pan under the radiator drain cock or under the lower radiator hose depending on the vehicle. Refer to Cooling System Draining and Filling in SI. 7. Loosen the radiator drain cock if equipped or use J 38185 clamp pliers and reposition the clamp on the lower radiator hose at the radiator. 8. Remove the end of the lower radiator hose from the radiator. 9. Drain the engine coolant sufficiently below the level of the ECT sensor. 10. Close the radiator drain cock or connect the lower radiator hose at the radiator. 11. Use the J 38185 clamp pliers to place the clamp into the original position on the hose. 12. Lower the vehicle. 13. Disconnect the wiring harness connector from the ECT sensor (2). 14. Remove the ECT sensor (1) from the front of the cylinder head. 15. Remove the corresponding size plug at the rear of the OTHER cylinder head. 16. Coat the threads of the ECT sensor with sealer. Use GM P/N 12346004 (Canadian P/N 10953480) or an equivalent. 17. Install the ECT sensor in the hole of the cylinder head where the plug was removed. Tighten Tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb ft). 18. Coat the threads of the plug with sealer. Use GM P/N 12346004 (Canadian P/N 10953480) or an equivalent. 19. Install the plug in the hole of the cylinder head where the ECT sensor was removed Tighten Tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb ft). Important Leave enough wire attached to the ECT sensor harness connector in order to create manageable splices that are at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splice. Page 8293 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 8746 Page 1533 Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under the 5 year / 100,000 mile (160,000 km) emission warranty, use: Warranty Information (Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 7538 6. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by pressing on the tang. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (SENSOR) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) tool into the cavity on the lower right hand face of the connector until the terminal release tang access panel slides over. Page 393 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Ensure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the Terminal Removal Procedure. Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PULL TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL If the terminal is visibly damaged or is suspected of having a faulty connection, the terminal should be replaced. Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors: 1. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) device and/or the secondary lock. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component or separate the connectors for in-line connectors. 3. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device. 4. Insert the proper pick or removal tool into the front of the connector body. 5. IMPORTANT: On connectors with more than one terminal the service loop may not be large enough to remove the terminal and crimp on a new one. If the terminal wire does not have a large enough service loop for removal, cut the wire 5 cm (2 in) behind the connector before removal. Grasp the wire at the back of the connector body and gently push the terminal out the front of the connector body. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. If the wire needed to be cut in order to remove the terminal, gently push a small length of the same size wire through the back of the connector cavity until there is enough wire exposed in order to crimp on a new terminal. If the wire was not cut, cut the existing wire as close to the old terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 4. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. TERMINAL INSTALLATION 1. Align the terminal and pull the wire from the back of the connector in order to seat the terminal. 2. If necessary, cut the new wire to proper length and splice with existing circuit. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. 3. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply dielectric grease to the connector. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PUSH TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 8968 Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size. REPAIRING A FUSIBLE LINK IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient overload protection. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. Flat Wire Repairs FLAT WIRE REPAIRS NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced. GMLAN Wiring Repairs GMLAN WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The GM Local Area Network (GMLAN) System requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working on GMLAN connectors and terminals. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items in order to repair the GMLAN wiring: Dura Seal splice sleeves - A wire stripping tool - J 38125-8 Crimping Tool (GM P/N 12085115) - J 38125-5 Ultra Torch Special Tool (GM P/N 12085116) The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. - A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors GMLAN REPAIRS IMPORTANT: When making a repair to any GMLAN network, the original wire length after the repair must be the same length as before the repair. If the network is a twisted pair, the twist must be maintained after the repair is completed. GMLAN has 2 types of networks, low speed and high speed. Low speed GMLAN has a single wire and works at slow speeds. High speed GMLAN has 2 wires in a twisted pair and works at higher speeds. For more information on GMLAN, refer to Data Link Communications Description and Operation. GMLAN CONNECTOR TERMINAL REPAIR IMPORTANT: A service terminal can be used to replace damaged connector terminals for both high speed and low speed GMLAN systems. When making a connector terminal repair on a GMLAN high speed system with twisted pair wires, do not untwist the wires more than necessary to make the repair. The terminals in the GMLAN system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are available in the J-38125. If the individual terminals are damaged on any GMLAN connection, use the appropriate connector repair procedure in order to repair the terminal. GMLAN WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 3298 2. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 4641 8. Insert the J 38125-213 into the small terminal release hole on the nose piece and gently pull on the back of the wire. 9. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Repairing Connector Terminals REPAIRING CONNECTOR TERMINALS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following: Push to Seat terminals - Pull to Seat terminals Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your terminal repair. The J-38125 contains further information. 1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.For cable seal terminals, remove the seal. 2. Apply the correct cable seal per gage size of the wire, if used.Slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation removal. 3. Remove the insulation. 4. For sealed terminals only, align the seal with the end of the cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal.For sealed terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal. 6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.For sealed terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable. 8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals excepting Micro-Pack 100.64 size. Soldering Micro-Pack 100 World terminals may damage the terminal. Sumitomo Connectors SUMITOMO CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 3416 4. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the rear of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. 5. Once the locking tabs are unlocked, slide the inner connector out of the rear of the connector housing. Page 178 vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide variety of actions, including: - Wiggling the harness - Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting - Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector - Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation - Relocating a harness or wires All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. Another option is, with the component commanded ON and OFF by the scan tool, move related connectors and wiring and observe the component operation. With the engine running, move related connectors and wiring while monitoring engine operation. If harness or connector movement affects the data displayed, component/system operation, or engine operation, inspect and repair the harness/connections as necessary. You may need to load the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these cases you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide good results as well. There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions, along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the circuit to these kinds of conditions. SALT WATER SPRAY Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture. Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5 percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously. HIGH TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070. Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault condition. The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis. This option does not allow for the same control, however. LOW TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect. If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to -18°C (0°F) from one end and +71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized cooling needs. Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or components in an effort to duplicate the concern. DUPLICATING FAILURE CONDITIONS - If none of the previous tests are successful, attempt to duplicate and/or capture the failure conditions. Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, where applicable, contains the conditions that were present when the DTC set. 1. Review and record Freeze Frame/Failure Records data. 2. Clear the DTCs using the scan tool. 3. Turn the key to OFF and wait 15 seconds. 4. Operate the vehicle under the same conditions that were noted in Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, as closely as possible. The vehicle must also be operating within the Conditions for Running the DTC. Refer to Conditions for Running the DTC in the supporting text if a DTC is being diagnosed. 5. Monitor DTC Status for the DTC being tested. The scan tool will indicate Ran, when the enabling conditions have been satisfied long enough for the DTC to run. The scan tool will also indicate whether the DTC passed or failed. - An alternate method is to drive the vehicle with the DMM connected to a suspected circuit. An abnormal reading on the DMM when the concern occurs, may help you locate the concern. Measuring Frequency Page 8249 Release the tabs that are holding the wiredress cover to the connector body. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the slots on both ends of the connector body. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. J 38125-216 can also be used to remove the nose piece. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by lifting the terminal retaining tabs on the inside of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 2303 Page 8254 IMPORTANT: Ensure that the dress cover and connector body are both in the released position before reassembling. Failure to do so may cause damage to the connector and component. Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (0.64) BOSCH CONNECTORS (0.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While pressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock until the lever is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Pull the rubber boot that covers the wires back to expose the end of the connector dress cover. 4. Place the connector locking lever in the center of the connector. 5. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs that are on the wire end of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover and connector body and pry up. Page 5775 Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Remove the fuel tank. 2. Disconnect the fuel tank pressure sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove the fuel tank pressure sensor. Installation Procedure 1. Install the fuel tank pressure sensor. 2. Connect the fuel tank pressure sensor electrical connector. 3. Install the fuel tank. Page 2918 1. Correctly position the spark plug washer. 2. Inspect the spark plug gap. Adjust the gap as needed. Spark plug gap: 1.524 mm (0.06 in) 3. Hand start the spark plug in the corresponding cylinder. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 4. Tighten the spark plug. * For used heads, tighten the plug to 15 N.m (11 lb ft). * For NEW heads, tighten the plug to 20 N.m (15 lb ft). 5. Install the spark plug wire. 6. If removed, install the washer solvent container. Page 2385 6. Gently pry the plastic terminal retainer down and carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (16-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, pull the two connector halves apart. Page 4111 Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under the 5 year / 100,000 mile (160,000 km) emission warranty, use: Warranty Information (Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 1545 Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagrams Engine Controls Connector End Views Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor Page 4825 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully raise the TPA on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA cannot be removed from the connector while there are terminals present in the connector body. View of the TPA when removed from the connector body. 4. Use the J 38125-12A tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the left side of the terminal release cavity as shown in the graphic. Use the tool to move the terminal release to the right with a gentle prying motion. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 2827 Behind The Center Of The I/P (With RPO Code W49) Page 5127 8. Take a CLEAR digital picture of the Tech 2(R) Vehicle Information screen showing the engine Calibration IDs and Verification Numbers as shown above. Retain the printout information and the Tech 2(R) screen photograph with the repair order. Note All pictures must be sent as a.jpg file. 9. E-mail a copy of the picture to [email protected]. In the subject line of the e-mail include the phrase "V8 Cal" as well as the complete VIN and Dealer BAC. In the body of the e-mail, include the VIN, mileage, R.O. number and BAC. Include a brief description of the customer concern and cause of the concern. Note The dealer will receive an e-mail reply after the calibrations have been validated. The e-mail reply will advise the dealer if the calibrations are OEM. 10. Allow two hours for the PQC to verify the calibrations and set up the case details. ‹› If the PQC determines that the calibrations ARE aftermarket calibrations, DO NOT contact GM Technical Assistance to discuss warranty concerns on the aftermarket calibrations. ALL questions and concerns about warranty should be directed to the dealers Fixed Operations Manager (FOM), (Warranty Manager (WM) in Canada). 11. You may call the PQC two hours after submitting the e-mail for authorization to replace the assembly. This will provide them time to receive, review and set up a case on the request. Please be prepared to provide all the usual documentation that is normally required when requesting an assembly authorization from the PQC. Tech 2(R) Displaying All Zeroes for the Verification Numbers on the Calibration ID and Verification Number Screen If the Tech 2(R) that you are using displays all zeroes for the Verification Numbers as shown, then perform the following steps: 1. Update the Tech 2(R) with the latest software from TIS2WEB. 2. Turn OFF the ignition for 90 seconds. 3. Connect the Tech 2(R) to the vehicle. 4. Turn ON the ignition, and build the vehicle. Observe the Tech 2(R) Calibration ID and Verification Number screen for proper operation. ‹› If the Tech 2(R) screen still does not display properly, then turn OFF the ignition for 90 seconds again. Turn ON the ignition and observe the same screen for proper operation. Retrieving Calibrations From a Global A Vehicle This information applies to the 2010 Camaro and is typical of the procedure that will be used on Global A vehicles. 1. Turn OFF the ignition. Page 976 6. Release the bracket TCM retainer (1). 7. Tilt the TCM (2) away from the ECM/TCM bracket. 8. Remove the TCM (1) from the TCM bracket (2). 9. Only when replacement of the ECM/TCM bracket (2) is necessary, remove the ECM (3). Refer to Engine Control Module Replacement for the 5.3L engine. Page 379 - Kostel - Molex - Sumitomo - Tyco/AMP - Yazaki Identifying the manufacturer of a connector is often difficult. When trying to determine the manufacturer of a connector, look for specific identifying marks that are unique to that connector supplier. Most of these identify marks are hard to find or see. Check the connector carefully and refer to the information below for pictures and descriptions of connector identification markings. - Most of AFLs connectors have EPC on their connector body. Some of the smaller connectors will not have any markings on them. - In some cases Bosch will actually be printed on the connector. If Bosch does not appear on the connector, look for the Bosch logo. The Bosch logo is a circle with a blunted arrow inside. This logo can appear anywhere on the connector and is often very small. Page 5191 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) and slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. Page 522 8. Insert the J 38125-213 into the small terminal release hole on the nose piece and gently pull on the back of the wire. 9. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Repairing Connector Terminals REPAIRING CONNECTOR TERMINALS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following: Push to Seat terminals - Pull to Seat terminals Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your terminal repair. The J-38125 contains further information. 1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.For cable seal terminals, remove the seal. 2. Apply the correct cable seal per gage size of the wire, if used.Slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation removal. 3. Remove the insulation. 4. For sealed terminals only, align the seal with the end of the cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal.For sealed terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal. 6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.For sealed terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable. 8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals excepting Micro-Pack 100.64 size. Soldering Micro-Pack 100 World terminals may damage the terminal. Sumitomo Connectors SUMITOMO CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 6272 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the DuraSeal splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of a connector. CPAs are used in all SIR System connectors and also in some connectors of other systems. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals of a connection. TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE CLIPS IMPORTANT: When making a splice in an area that may be exposed to moisture use a crimp and seal splice sleeve instead of a Splice Clip. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. Page 5486 breakers are used. CIRCUIT BREAKER This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high current is removed. POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) CIRCUIT BREAKER This type greatly increases its resistance when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker will re-close within a second or 2. Circuit Protection - Fuses CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSES The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and examine the element in the fuse for an open (2). If not broken (1), also check for continuity using a DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one of equal current rating. Circuit Protection - Fusible Links CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSIBLE LINKS Fuel Pressure Gage Installation and Removal Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection Fuel Pressure Gage Installation and Removal Fuel Pressure Gage Installation and Removal Tools Required CH-48027 Digital Pressure Gage Installation Procedure Caution: Refer to Gasoline/Gasoline Vapors Caution. Caution: Remove the fuel tank cap and relieve the fuel system pressure before servicing the fuel system in order to reduce the risk of personal injury. After you relieve the fuel system pressure, a small amount of fuel may be released when servicing the fuel lines, the fuel injection pump, or the connections. In order to reduce the risk of personal injury, cover the fuel system components with a shop towel before disconnection. This will catch any fuel that may leak out. Place the towel in an approved container when the disconnection is complete. 1. Relieve the fuel system pressure. Refer to Fuel Pressure Relief. 2. Connect the CH-48027-1 (1) to the CH-48027-2 (2). 3. Remove the shop towel from around the fuel rail service port, and place in an approved gasoline container. 4. Perform any tests and/or diagnostics as needed. For the proper usage of the CH-48027 , refer to the manufacture's directions. Removal Procedure Page 2593 7. Apply pressure and gently rock the cover until one locking leg is unseated. 8. Continue to apply pressure and rock the cover until the second locking leg is unseated. Repeat procedure for the other side of the dress cover and remove the cover. 9. Use J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) to gently lift the terminal retaining tab while gently pulling the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 10. If the terminal is severely bent or damaged, it may be possible on some connectors to push the wire out of the front of the connector instead of Page 8231 Utility/Van Zoning UTILITY/VAN ZONING Page 1120 20. Extract a portion of the ECT sensor harness wiring and connector from the protective conduit. Cut off the ECT sensor harness connector and wiring. 21. Determine a routing path for the ECT sensor jumper harness wires so that they can be secured TO or WITHIN an existing protective conduit. Note This step is to set up and verify the length of wiring that is required before cutting. 22. Route the ECT sensor jumper wires and then enclose them in their own protective conduit in order to VERIFY the length that is required. 23. Cut the ECT sensor jumper wires to the appropriate length. Note Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splice or connector. 24. Splice the ECT sensor jumper wires to the ORIGINAL ECT HARNESS LOCATION using DuraSeal weatherproof splices. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves in SI. Note Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splice or connector. 25. Splice the ECT sensor jumper wires to the ECT SENSOR HARNESS CONNECTOR using DuraSeal weatherproof splices. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves in SI. 26. Connect the ECT sensor harness connector to the ECT sensor. 27. Secure the ECT sensor jumper wires that are in their own protective conduit TO or WITHIN the existing harness conduit using tie straps. Important You MUST run the engine at the specified RPM and until it reaches normal operating temperature and then allow it to idle as indicated in SI. The engine MUST then be allowed to cool down in order to top off the coolant level as needed. 28. Fill the cooling system to the proper level. Refer to Cooling System Draining and Filling in SI. 29. Pressure test the cooling system. Refer to Cooling System Leak Testing in SI. 30. Use a scan tool to clear any DTCs. Relocating the Engine Coolant Heater Cord Important For reference, the procedure and graphics that are shown are from a Chevrolet Silverado, but are similar for the other vehicles listed above. 1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Ask the customer where they would prefer the extension cord to exit from the engine compartment in order to determine the required extension cord length. 3. Obtain an extension cord with the following features: - 120 volt - 14/3 gauge - 15A capacity - Three prong - Polarized plug and receptacle - Chemical resistant - Grounded terminals - Designed for use in a cold outdoor environment - Outer jacket resistant to deterioration from moisture, abrasion and exposure to sunlight - Maximum length of 2.5-3 m (8-10 ft) 4. Release enough of the clips that retain the engine coolant heater cord to the vehicle to provide the necessary length for repositioning. 5. Apply dielectric grease to the electrical contacts of the heater cord receptacle and the extension cord plug to prevent corrosion. Use GM P/N 12345579 (in Canada, use P/N 10953481) or an equivalent. 6. Connect the heater cord receptacle to the extension cord plug and wipe OFF any excess grease. TPMS System - Service And Re-Learning Sensor IDs Tire Pressure Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins TPMS System - Service And Re-Learning Sensor IDs INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 10-03-16-001 Date: July 19, 2010 Subject: TPMS System Service and Re-Learning Sensor IDs Models: 2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2 2009 and Prior HUMMER H3 2010 and Prior Saturn Models 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X with Wheel-Mounted Tire Pressure Sensors In the event that the spare tire, which is normally not equipped with a tire pressure monitor (TPM) sensor, is installed in place of one of the road tires and the vehicle is driven above 40 km/h (25 mph) for 20 minutes or more, the TPM indicator icon on the instrument panel cluster (IPC) will flash for approximately one minute and then remain on steady each time the ignition is turned ON, indicating a diagnostic trouble code (DTC) has been set. The driver information center (DIC), if equipped, will also display a SERVICE TIRE MONITOR type message. When the road tire is repaired and reinstalled in the original location, the TPM indicator icon illumination and DIC message may remain displayed until the DTC is cleared. To ensure that the TPM indicator and the DIC message are cleared after service, it is necessary to clear any TPM DTCs using a scan tool. If a scan tool is unavailable, performing the TPM relearn procedure using a TPM diagnostic tool will provide the same results. It is advised to perform the relearn procedure away from other vehicles to prevent picking up a stray sensor signal. If one or more of the TPM sensors are missing or damaged and have been replaced, then the relearn procedure must be performed. Disclaimer Page 8652 MEASURING FREQUENCY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal. IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM to autorange to an appropriate range. 1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency measured. Measuring Voltage MEASURING VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit. 1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods: - Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. - Turn ON the engine. - Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls. - Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested. 3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The DMM displays the voltage measured at that point. Measuring Voltage Drop MEASURING VOLTAGE DROP NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points. Probing Electrical Connectors PROBING ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS Page 2290 6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias. Reference the appropriate service manual wiring schematic to obtain the correct diode installation position. 7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for the soldering equipment. 8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed. 9. IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode attachment points with tape. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape. Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable SPLICING TWISTED OR SHIELDED CABLE Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable. 1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splice is made. 3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire. Staggering the splices by 65 mm (2.5 in) is recommended. 4. IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical contact with the drain wire. Re-assemble the cable. Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape. - Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1). - Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire. - Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape. Page 6224 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Ensure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the Terminal Removal Procedure. Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PULL TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL If the terminal is visibly damaged or is suspected of having a faulty connection, the terminal should be replaced. Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors: 1. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) device and/or the secondary lock. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component or separate the connectors for in-line connectors. 3. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device. 4. Insert the proper pick or removal tool into the front of the connector body. 5. IMPORTANT: On connectors with more than one terminal the service loop may not be large enough to remove the terminal and crimp on a new one. If the terminal wire does not have a large enough service loop for removal, cut the wire 5 cm (2 in) behind the connector before removal. Grasp the wire at the back of the connector body and gently push the terminal out the front of the connector body. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. If the wire needed to be cut in order to remove the terminal, gently push a small length of the same size wire through the back of the connector cavity until there is enough wire exposed in order to crimp on a new terminal. If the wire was not cut, cut the existing wire as close to the old terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 4. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. TERMINAL INSTALLATION 1. Align the terminal and pull the wire from the back of the connector in order to seat the terminal. 2. If necessary, cut the new wire to proper length and splice with existing circuit. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. 3. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply dielectric grease to the connector. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PUSH TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 4900 Release the tabs that are holding the wiredress cover to the connector body. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the slots on both ends of the connector body. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. J 38125-216 can also be used to remove the nose piece. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by lifting the terminal retaining tabs on the inside of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 7985 vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide variety of actions, including: - Wiggling the harness - Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting - Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector - Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation - Relocating a harness or wires All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. Another option is, with the component commanded ON and OFF by the scan tool, move related connectors and wiring and observe the component operation. With the engine running, move related connectors and wiring while monitoring engine operation. If harness or connector movement affects the data displayed, component/system operation, or engine operation, inspect and repair the harness/connections as necessary. You may need to load the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these cases you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide good results as well. There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions, along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the circuit to these kinds of conditions. SALT WATER SPRAY Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture. Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5 percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously. HIGH TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070. Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault condition. The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis. This option does not allow for the same control, however. LOW TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect. If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to -18°C (0°F) from one end and +71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized cooling needs. Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or components in an effort to duplicate the concern. DUPLICATING FAILURE CONDITIONS - If none of the previous tests are successful, attempt to duplicate and/or capture the failure conditions. Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, where applicable, contains the conditions that were present when the DTC set. 1. Review and record Freeze Frame/Failure Records data. 2. Clear the DTCs using the scan tool. 3. Turn the key to OFF and wait 15 seconds. 4. Operate the vehicle under the same conditions that were noted in Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, as closely as possible. The vehicle must also be operating within the Conditions for Running the DTC. Refer to Conditions for Running the DTC in the supporting text if a DTC is being diagnosed. 5. Monitor DTC Status for the DTC being tested. The scan tool will indicate Ran, when the enabling conditions have been satisfied long enough for the DTC to run. The scan tool will also indicate whether the DTC passed or failed. - An alternate method is to drive the vehicle with the DMM connected to a suspected circuit. An abnormal reading on the DMM when the concern occurs, may help you locate the concern. Measuring Frequency Page 5490 The engine harness may be repaired using the J-38125. High Temperature Wiring Repairs HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperatures, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time may use materials i.e. wires, connectors, and shielding that has a higher heat rating than typical wiring. When making a repair in a high temperature area observe the following: Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature to replace any damaged wire. - Replace any heat shielding that is removed. - Cover any DuraSeal splice sleeves with SCT1 shrink tubing (available in the J-38125 Terminal Repair kit). - After making a wiring repair, ensure that the location of the wiring is not moved closer to the heat source. IDENTIFYING HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperature, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time need special considerations when making wiring repairs. Areas that may be exposed to higher temperatures can be identified by heat resistant materials that are being used in those areas. These materials may include heat reflective tape, moon tape, and high temperature shrink tubing. Also conduit and other protective coverings may be used. Because conduit or similar coverings are used throughout the vehicle regardless of the temperature, it may be necessary for the technician to determine if an area is exposed to excessive heat before making a wiring repair. Obvious areas of consideration would be any area located near the exhaust manifolds, catalytic converter, and exhaust pipes. The J-38125 contains much of the material you will need to perform repairs on areas exposed to high heat. The kit contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves to crimp and seal connections - High temperature SCT1 shrink tubing to protect the splice sleeves - A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct crimp tool to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools to remove the terminals from the connectors The J-38125 does not contain wire that is suitable to high temperature exposure. Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature of the same or larger gage size as the original wire when repair damage wire. Also replace any reflective tape that you remove during the repair. HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature rating of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125 and then encapsulate the splice sleeve using the high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the order listed. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip keeping all of the wire strands intact. Page 8641 Page 1338 - Yazaki has a wedge or arrow shape, similar to that shown. Delphi Connectors (Micro .64) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro 64 connectors. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. The lever lock may be located on the top or sides of the wire dress cover. Page 3307 6. Gently pry the plastic terminal retainer down and carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (16-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, pull the two connector halves apart. Page 3369 IMPORTANT: Ensure that the dress cover and connector body are both in the released position before reassembling. Failure to do so may cause damage to the connector and component. Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (0.64) BOSCH CONNECTORS (0.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While pressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock until the lever is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Pull the rubber boot that covers the wires back to expose the end of the connector dress cover. 4. Place the connector locking lever in the center of the connector. 5. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs that are on the wire end of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover and connector body and pry up. Page 6423 View of connector in released position. 4. Disconnect the connector from the component. 5. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Release the rear lower half of the wiredress cover. Page 8703 MOLEX CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. 2. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. Page 6718 9. The illustration shows a cutaway view of the connector to aid the technician in releasing the terminal retainer. 10. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Terminal Position Assurance Locks TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Tyco/Amp Connectors (CM 42-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (CM 42-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the connector body and pull the CPA out. The CPA is on the wire harness side of connector. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 619 Body Control Module: Service and Repair Liftgate Control Module Replacement LIFTGATE CONTROL MODULE REPLACEMENT REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Remove the liftgate trim panel. 2. Disconnect the electrical connectors (3) from the module as necessary. 3. Remove the bolts that retain the module to the liftgate. 4. Remove the module from the liftgate. INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 1. Install the module to the liftgate. 2. NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice. Install the bolts that retain the module to the liftgate. Tighten the bolts to 10 N.m (89 lb in). 3. Connect the electrical connectors (3) as necessary. 4. Install the liftgate trim panel. 5. Program the liftgate control module. Refer to Control Module References. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Page 6489 If a wire is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm, etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except coaxial. - Do not use the DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent American wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Specifications Compression Check: Specifications Compression Check Start with the compression gage at zero and crank the engine through 4 compression strokes, 4 puffs. Measure the compression for each cylinder. Record the readings. If a cylinder has low compression, inject approximately 15 ml (1 tablespoon) of engine oil into the combustion chamber through the spark plug hole. Measure the compression again and record the reading. The minimum compression in any 1 cylinder should not be less than 70 percent of the highest cylinder. No cylinder should read less than 690 kPa (100 psi). For example, if the highest pressure in any 1 cylinder is 1,035 kPa (150 psi), the lowest allowable pressure for any other cylinder would be 725 kPa (105 psi). (1 035 x 70% = 725) (150 x 70% = 105). Page 7334 It is very important to use the correct test adapter when testing for proper terminal contact of fuses and relays in a bussed electrical center (BEC). Use J-35616-35 to test for proper terminal contact. Failure to use J-35616-35 can result in improper diagnosis of the BEC. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Separate the connector halves. 2. Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body. 3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J-38125 , test that the retention force is significantly different between a good terminal and a suspect terminal. Replace the female terminal in question. FLAT WIRE (DOCK AND LOCK) CONNECTORS There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock) connectors on the harness side or the component side. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Remove the component in question. 2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side of the connector as oil from your skin may be a source of contamination as well. 3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other imperfections that could cause poor terminal contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are uniform and free of damage or deformation. 4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the on the flat wire harness connector in order to test the circuit in question. CONTROL MODULE/COMPONENT VOLTAGE AND GROUNDS Poor voltage or ground connections can cause widely varying symptoms. Test all control module voltage supply circuits. Many vehicles have multiple circuits supplying voltage to a control module. Other components in the system may have separate voltage supply circuits that may also need to be tested. Inspect connections at the module/component connectors, fuses, and any intermediate connections between the voltage source and the module/component. A test lamp or a DMM may indicate that voltage is present, but neither tests the ability of the circuit to carry sufficient current. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Power Distribution Schematics. - Test all control module ground and system ground circuits. The control module may have multiple ground circuits. Other components in the system may have separate grounds that may also need to be tested. Inspect grounds for clean and tight connections at the grounding point. Inspect the connections at the component and in splice packs, where applicable. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Ground Distribution Schematics. TEMPERATURE SENSITIVITY - An intermittent condition may occur when a component/connection reaches normal operating temperature. The condition may occur only when the component/connection is cold, or only when the component/connection is hot. - Freeze Frame, Failure Records, Snapshot, or Vehicle Data Recorder data may help with this type of intermittent condition, where applicable. - If the intermittent is related to heat, review the data for a relationship with the following: High ambient temperatures - Underhood/engine generated heat - Circuit generated heat due to a poor connection, or high electrical load - Higher than normal load conditions, towing, etc. - If the intermittent is related to cold, review the data for the following: Low ambient temperatures-In extremely low temperatures, ice may form in a connection or component. Inspect for water intrusion. - The condition only occurs on a cold start. - The condition goes away when the vehicle warms up. - Information from the customer may help to determine if the trouble follows a pattern that is temperature related. - If temperature is suspected of causing an intermittent fault condition, attempt to duplicate the condition. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required. ELECTROMAGNETIC INTERFERENCE (EMI) AND ELECTRICAL NOISE Some electrical components/circuits are sensitive to electromagnetic interference (EMI) or other types of electrical noise. Inspect for the following conditions: A misrouted harness that is too close to high voltage/high current devices such as secondary ignition components, motors, generator etc-These components may induce electrical noise on a circuit that could interfere with normal circuit operation. - Electrical system interference caused by a malfunctioning relay, or a control module driven solenoid or switch-These conditions can cause a sharp electrical surge. Normally, the condition will occur when the malfunctioning component is operating. - Improper installation of non-factory or aftermarket add on accessories such as lights, 2-way radios, amplifiers, electric motors, remote starters, alarm systems, cell phones, etc-These accessories may lead to interference while in use, but do not fail when the accessories are not in use. - Test for an open diode across the A/C compressor clutch and for other open diodes. Some relays may contain a clamping diode. - The generator may be allowing AC noise into the electrical system. INCORRECT CONTROL MODULE - There are only a few situations where reprogramming a control module is appropriate: A new service control module is installed. Page 8311 View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. 4. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers CIRCUIT PROTECTION - CIRCUIT BREAKERS A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types of circuit Page 8136 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (BSK) BOSCH CONNECTORS (BSK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 3. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 4. Insert the J 38125-561 tool into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 5. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is Page 4417 4. Slide the dress cover forward and off of the connector. 5. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front and rear of the connector. Page 6348 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully raise the TPA on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA cannot be removed from the connector while there are terminals present in the connector body. View of the TPA when removed from the connector body. 4. Use the J 38125-12A tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the left side of the terminal release cavity as shown in the graphic. Use the tool to move the terminal release to the right with a gentle prying motion. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 6737 The engine harness may be repaired using the J-38125. High Temperature Wiring Repairs HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperatures, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time may use materials i.e. wires, connectors, and shielding that has a higher heat rating than typical wiring. When making a repair in a high temperature area observe the following: Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature to replace any damaged wire. - Replace any heat shielding that is removed. - Cover any DuraSeal splice sleeves with SCT1 shrink tubing (available in the J-38125 Terminal Repair kit). - After making a wiring repair, ensure that the location of the wiring is not moved closer to the heat source. IDENTIFYING HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperature, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time need special considerations when making wiring repairs. Areas that may be exposed to higher temperatures can be identified by heat resistant materials that are being used in those areas. These materials may include heat reflective tape, moon tape, and high temperature shrink tubing. Also conduit and other protective coverings may be used. Because conduit or similar coverings are used throughout the vehicle regardless of the temperature, it may be necessary for the technician to determine if an area is exposed to excessive heat before making a wiring repair. Obvious areas of consideration would be any area located near the exhaust manifolds, catalytic converter, and exhaust pipes. The J-38125 contains much of the material you will need to perform repairs on areas exposed to high heat. The kit contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves to crimp and seal connections - High temperature SCT1 shrink tubing to protect the splice sleeves - A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct crimp tool to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools to remove the terminals from the connectors The J-38125 does not contain wire that is suitable to high temperature exposure. Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature of the same or larger gage size as the original wire when repair damage wire. Also replace any reflective tape that you remove during the repair. HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature rating of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125 and then encapsulate the splice sleeve using the high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the order listed. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip keeping all of the wire strands intact. Page 6952 If a wire is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm, etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except coaxial. - Do not use the DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent American wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 6651 Page 4963 breakers are used. CIRCUIT BREAKER This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high current is removed. POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) CIRCUIT BREAKER This type greatly increases its resistance when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker will re-close within a second or 2. Circuit Protection - Fuses CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSES The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and examine the element in the fuse for an open (2). If not broken (1), also check for continuity using a DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one of equal current rating. Circuit Protection - Fusible Links CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSIBLE LINKS Page 1425 Checking Aftermarket Accessories CHECKING AFTERMARKET ACCESSORIES Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits: - CAUTION: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol. - NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice. OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol. Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the cause of the problems. Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include: Power feeds connected to points other than the battery - Antenna location - Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring - Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line - Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories. Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions INDUCING INTERMITTENT FAULT CONDITIONS TOOLS REQUIRED J 25070 Heat Gun Many intermittent open or shorted circuits are affected by harness/connector movement that is caused by vibration, engine torque, bumps/rough pavement, etc. In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness if the malfunction appears to be Page 5404 Page 2436 3. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. View showing depressing of the lever lock release tab. Page 5314 - Yazaki has a wedge or arrow shape, similar to that shown. Delphi Connectors (Micro .64) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro 64 connectors. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. The lever lock may be located on the top or sides of the wire dress cover. Page 2767 Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Diagrams Automatic Transmission Fluid Pressure (TFP) Manual Valve Position Switch, Wiring Harness Side Automatic Transmission Fluid Pressure (TFP) Manual Valve Position Switch, Wiring Harness Side Page 6072 - A control module from another vehicle is installed. - Revised software/calibration files have been released for this vehicle. - IMPORTANT: DO NOT re-program the control module with the SAME software/calibration files that are already present in the control module. This is not an effective repair for any type of concern. Verify that the control module contains the correct software/calibration. If incorrect programming is found, reprogram the control module with the most current software/calibration. Refer to Control Module References for replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Testing for Short to Ground TESTING FOR SHORT TO GROUND NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 4. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit. With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is a short to ground in the circuit. Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2. Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). - When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. - If the DMM does not display voltage 4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is shorted. Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A DIGITAL MULTIMETER NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the powertrain control module (PCM), should only be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200 Digital Multimeter (DMM). The J 39200 instruction manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminage even though voltage is present. The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity. IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading. Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the measurement. Page 2802 Front Passenger Door Module (FPDM) Page 7310 8. Take a CLEAR digital picture of the Tech 2(R) Vehicle Information screen showing the engine Calibration IDs and Verification Numbers as shown above. Retain the printout information and the Tech 2(R) screen photograph with the repair order. 9. E-mail a copy of the picture to [email protected]. In the subject line of the e-mail include the phrase "V8 Cal" as well as the complete VIN and Dealer BAC. In the body of the e-mail, include the VIN, mileage, R.O. number and BAC. Include a brief description of the customer concern and cause of the concern. Note The dealer will receive an e-mail reply after the calibrations have been validated. The e-mail reply will advise the dealer if the calibrations are OEM. 10. Allow two hours for the PQC to verify the calibrations and set up the case details. ‹› If the PQC determines that the calibrations ARE aftermarket calibrations, DO NOT contact GM Technical Assistance to discuss warranty concerns on the aftermarket calibrations. ALL questions and concerns about warranty should be directed to the dealers Fixed Operations Manager (FOM), (Warranty Manager (WM) in Canada). 11. You may call the PQC two hours after submitting the e-mail for authorization to replace the assembly. This will provide them time to receive, review and set up a case on the request. Please be prepared to provide all the usual documentation that is normally required when requesting an assembly authorization from the PQC. Tech 2(R) Displaying All Zeroes for the Verification Numbers on the Calibration ID and Verification Number Screen If the Tech 2(R) that you are using displays all zeroes for the Verification Numbers as shown, then perform the following steps: 1. Update the Tech 2(R) with the latest software from TIS2WEB. 2. Turn OFF the ignition for 90 seconds. 3. Connect the Tech 2(R) to the vehicle. 4. Turn ON the ignition, and build the vehicle. Observe the Tech 2(R) Calibration ID and Verification Number screen for proper operation. ‹› If the Tech 2(R) screen still does not display properly, then turn OFF the ignition for 90 seconds again. Turn ON the ignition and observe the same screen for proper operation. Retrieving Calibrations From a Global A Vehicle This information applies to the 2010 Camaro and is typical of the procedure that will be used on Global A vehicles. 1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Connect the MDI to the Data Link Connector (DLC) of the vehicle. Note Use the USB port to make the following MDI connection: Page 6521 Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids Arrows and Symbols Arrows and Symbols This Service Data uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations. Arrows and Symbols 1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow Basic Knowledge Required GENERAL ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures contained in the service manual. You should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current (amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram, as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. Decimal and Metric Equivalents Decimal and Metric Equivalents Page 8840 2. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 5991 MOLEX CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. 2. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. Page 7235 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the DuraSeal splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of a connector. CPAs are used in all SIR System connectors and also in some connectors of other systems. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals of a connection. TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE CLIPS IMPORTANT: When making a splice in an area that may be exposed to moisture use a crimp and seal splice sleeve instead of a Splice Clip. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. Page 8686 pulling it through. This will prevent damage to the internal seals of the connector. Once the terminal is pushed out of the connector, cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible and pull the wire through the connector. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE The Micro-Pack 100W connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool was developed to crimp Micro-Pack 100W terminals. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 2. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert the terminal into the crimp tool until the core wings are flush with the anvil on the crimp tool. Be sure that the wings are pointed toward the crimp tool former and release the spring locator. The locator will hold the terminal in place. Inspect the alignment of the terminal wings with the crimp tool former. If the terminal wings are wider than the crimp tool former, remove the terminal and bend the terminal wings in slightly. 5. Place stripped wire into terminal. 6. Crimp the new terminal to the wire. If a jam occurs, press the emergency release to open applicator. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire perform the following procedure in order to replace Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. Page 1589 - JST connectors have JST in small letters on their connectors, similar to that above. The location of the logo will vary with the connector size and style. - Kostel has an "LK" with a circle around it. These connector are usually used as a transmissions connection and are currently use on some Cadillac vehicles. Page 5293 If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200 DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J 39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected. IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J 39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and maximum (MAX) values measured. 1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of a suspected circuit to the other. 2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J 39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep). IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value in order to record the full change. 5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling the connections or the wiring, test driving, or performing other operations. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions. 6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9. Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist. Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections TESTING FOR INTERMITTENT CONDITIONS AND POOR CONNECTIONS TOOLS REQUIRED - J 35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit - J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit When the condition is not currently present, but is indicated in DTC history, the cause may be intermittent. An intermittent may also be the cause when there is a customer complaint, but the symptom cannot be duplicated. Refer to the Symptom Table of the system that is suspect of causing the condition before trying to locate an intermittent condition. Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the following items: Wiring broken inside the insulation - Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector - Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself, and corrosion in the wire to terminal contact area, etc. - Pierced or damaged insulation can allow moisture to enter the wiring causing corrosion. The conductor can corrode inside the insulation, with little visible evidence. Look for swollen and stiff sections of wire in the suspect circuits. - Wiring which has been pinched, cut, or its insulation rubbed through may cause an intermittent open or short as the bare area touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle. - Wiring that comes in contact with hot or exhaust components - Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required, in order to verify the customer concern. - Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. - Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis and Vehicle Data Recorder operation. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any inline connectors before replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation. Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination, usually in the underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit. Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper adapter. Always use the J 35616 when probing connectors. Other causes of terminal deformation are improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT IN BUSSED ELECTRICAL CENTERS (BEC) Page 3775 5. Once the nose piece retainers are relaxed, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should raise slightly. 6. On the opposite side of the nose piece, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should release completely. If the nose piece does not come off, repeat the procedure on the opposite side. Page 1323 View of connector in released position. 4. Disconnect the connector from the component. 5. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Release the rear lower half of the wiredress cover. Page 7331 Refer to the following table as a guide in selecting the correct test adapter for front probing connectors: Backprobe IMPORTANT: Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures. - Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector. - Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large of a test probe. - After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected, test for proper terminal contact. Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the connector. Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure SCAN TOOL SNAPSHOT PROCEDURE Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used Page 6235 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully raise the TPA on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA cannot be removed from the connector while there are terminals present in the connector body. View of the TPA when removed from the connector body. 4. Use the J 38125-12A tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the left side of the terminal release cavity as shown in the graphic. Use the tool to move the terminal release to the right with a gentle prying motion. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 2922 Compression Check: Testing and Inspection Engine Compression Test 1. Charge the battery if the battery is not fully charged. 2. Disable the ignition system. 3. Disable the fuel injection system. 4. Remove all spark plugs. 5. Turn the ignition to the ON position. 6. Depress the accelerator pedal to position the throttle plate wide open. 7. Start with the compression gage at zero and crank the engine through 4 compression strokes, 4 puffs. 8. Measure the compression for each cylinder. Record the readings. 9. If a cylinder has low compression, inject approximately 15 ml (1 tablespoon) of engine oil into the combustion chamber through the spark plug hole. Measure the compression again and record the reading. 10. The minimum compression in any 1 cylinder should not be less than 70 percent of the highest cylinder. No cylinder should read less than 690 kPa (100 psi). For example, if the highest pressure in any 1 cylinder is 1 035 kPa (150 psi), the lowest allowable pressure for any other cylinder would be 725 kPa (105 psi). (1 035 x 70% = 725) (150 x 70% = 105). ^ Normal - Compression builds up quickly and evenly to the specified compression for each cylinder. ^ Piston Rings Leaking - Compression is low on the first stroke. Compression builds up with the following strokes, but does not reach normal. Compression improves considerably when you add oil. ^ Valves Leaking - Compression is low on the first stroke. Compression usually does not build up on the following strokes. Compression does not improve much when you add oil. ^ If 2 adjacent cylinders have lower than normal compression, and injecting oil into the cylinders does not increase the compression, the cause may be a head gasket leaking between the cylinders. Page 5446 pulling it through. This will prevent damage to the internal seals of the connector. Once the terminal is pushed out of the connector, cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible and pull the wire through the connector. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE The Micro-Pack 100W connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool was developed to crimp Micro-Pack 100W terminals. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 2. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert the terminal into the crimp tool until the core wings are flush with the anvil on the crimp tool. Be sure that the wings are pointed toward the crimp tool former and release the spring locator. The locator will hold the terminal in place. Inspect the alignment of the terminal wings with the crimp tool former. If the terminal wings are wider than the crimp tool former, remove the terminal and bend the terminal wings in slightly. 5. Place stripped wire into terminal. 6. Crimp the new terminal to the wire. If a jam occurs, press the emergency release to open applicator. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire perform the following procedure in order to replace Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. Page 2569 3. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. View showing depressing of the lever lock release tab. Page 2646 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches, and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original. - The wires insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the possibility of fuel contact. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1). 5. Select the proper duraseal splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool. Refer to the Crimp and Seal Splice Table. 6. Place the duraseal splice sleeve in the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115) crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 7. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to hold the duraseal splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 8. Insert the wires into the duraseal splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel in order to prevent the wire from passing through the splice (3). 9. Close the handles of the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115), until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is applied to the splice sleeve. 10. Shrink the insulation around the splice. - Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. - Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Splicing Inline Harness Diodes SPLICING INLINE HARNESS DIODES Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure. 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode. 2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool. 5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode. Page 6012 2. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully push the terminal position assurance (TPA) towards the face of the connector on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA is fragile and may break if not done carefully. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. 3. Use the J 38125-215 tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 617 8. Disconnect the 32-way tan electrical connector (2) from the BCM. 9. Disconnect the 24-way gray electrical connector (1) from the BCM. 10. With an upward motion, remove the BCM (1) from the rear electrical center. INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 1. Index the slots on the BCM (1) to the rear electrical center. 2. Using a downward motion, install the BCM to the rear electrical center. 3. Connect the 24-way gray electrical connector (1) to the BCM. 4. Connect the 32-way tan electrical connector (2) to the BCM. 5. Connect the 40-way body wiring extension (1) to the BCM. Page 1622 3. Remove the dress cover by using a flat-blade tool to release the connector locking tabs and pulling off the dress cover. 4. Relieve the tension on the nose piece retainers by inserting J-38125-12A (12094429) into the single retainer slot on the end of the nose piece and gently prying out the locking tab. Repeat the process for both of the nose piece locking tabs on the opposite side of the nose piece. Page 6180 Page 840 - In some cases Delphi will actually be printed on the connector. If Delphi is not printed on the connector, look for PED. In both cases there is no specific orientation for Delphi or PED and they can appear anywhere on the connector. - FCI connectors may have the FCI logo on their connectors. The logo is the letters FCI with an "A" above it. - JAE connector have JAE in small letters on their connectors. Page 6400 Page 4450 If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the DuraSeal splice sleeves. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: - Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. - Do not use the crimp and DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 to crimp DuraSeal splice sleeve. In order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 5005 Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Specifications Temperature Versus Resistance Page 6816 5. Remove paint and primer from the area surrounding the 10 mm (0.40 in) until bare metal is visible. Important The M6 conductive rivet stud as shown, can accommodate a panel thickness range of 0.7-4.2 mm (0.03-0.17 in). If there are layers of sheet metal, they should be touching without any air gaps to ensure a good ground. 6. Select a M6 conductive rivet stud. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. Note Use the GE-50317 rivet stud tool kit. 7. Place the M6 conductive rivet stud (1) in the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole. Assemble the rivet stud tool (2) with the groove and flare side facing the rivet stud, then the washer and the M6 nut (3). 8. Using a wrench on the rivet stud tool, and a socket on the M6 nut, secure the M6 conductive rivet stud. 9. Ensure the new rivet stud is securely fastened, WITHOUT ANY detectable movement. 10. Completely wrap the threads of the rivet stud with painters tape or equivalent. Page 8736 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link). - The wire insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. 5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold them between thumb and forefinger. 7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place. - Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction. - Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip. 8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool closes.Ensure that no strands of wire are cut. 10. Crimp the splice on each end (2). Page 7077 6. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by pressing on the tang. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (SENSOR) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) tool into the cavity on the lower right hand face of the connector until the terminal release tang access panel slides over. Page 3697 * When lifting or jacking a vehicle, be certain that the lift pads do not contact the exhaust system, brake pipes, cables, HVAC lines, wiring harnesses, fuel lines, or underbody. Such contact may result in damage or unsatisfactory vehicle performance. * When using a frame-contact hoist, only place the pads on flat surfaces. Do not place pads within 50 mm (2 in) of any radius. * Before lifting the vehicle, verify that the vehicle loads are secure and equally distributed. * When major components are removed from the vehicle when supported on a hoist, support the vehicle with jack stands at the opposite end from which the components are being removed and secure the vehicle frame to the hoist pads nearest the component to be removed. Vehicle Jacking * Park the vehicle on a clean, hard, level surface before jacking the vehicle. * Any time you lift the vehicle on one end, chock the wheels at the opposite end. * Use jack stands in order to provide support. * When supporting the vehicle using jack stands, place the jack stands under the side rails or the axle. * When lifting under the rear differential, do not allow the jack pad to contact the rear stabilizer bar or mounting hardware. Page 1350 The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors. 1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position. 4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool J 38125-10A (GM P/N 12014012-1) into the front (mating end) of the connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal through the back of the connector (2). IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector. 6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. 7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily. 10. Perform system check. Delphi Connectors (12 Way) DELPHI CONNECTORS (12-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. Page 5374 11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the solder equipment. 12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. 13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to cover the first piece of tape. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE SLEEVES TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit IMPORTANT: Use only dura seal splice sleeves. Other splice sleeves may not protect the splice from moisture or provide a good electrical connection. Use duraseal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. Use duraseal splice sleeves where there is special requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire using duraseal splice sleeves. Page 3341 Page 3534 ^ When adding proper tire air pressure, it is important to remember fluctuations in outside air temperatures and tire temperatures effect tire air pressures. ^ After you have added the proper tire pressure, if the vehicle has a DIC (after the system has updated), check to see if DIC displays are the same readings as the tire pressure gauge used (adjust as necessary). ^ Only perform a TPM sensor re-learn after a tire rotation or system part replacements and use the Tech 2(R) to initiate the relearn whenever possible to avoid invalid sensor I.D. learns. Important: Always take outside temperature and tire temperature into consideration to properly set tire pressures. Foe example, on colder days (20°F/-7°C), if setting tire pressure when the vehicle has been indoors (60°F/16°C) or the tires are warm from being driven, it will be necessary to compensate for the low outside temperature by adding 21-27 kPa (3-4 psi) more then the placecard pressure. At some later time, when the vehicle has been parked outside for a while, the tires will cool off and the pressures will drop back into the placecard range. Important: Recently, nitrogen gas (for use in inflating tires) has become available to the general customer through some retailers. The use of nitrogen gas to inflate tires is a technology used in automobile racing. Tires inflated with nitrogen gas may exhibit less of a pressure change in response to outside temperature changes. Nitrogen gas inflation is compatible with GM TPM sensors. For additional information, refer to Corporate Service Bulletin 05-03-10-020C. Important: All Models (Except the Pontiac Vibe): Do not perform a TPM relearn at PDI, the system has already been set at the Assembly Plant. Do not perform a TPM relearn after adding air to the tires. The low tire light is similar to the low fuel indicator and adding something (fuel, air) to the vehicle makes that light turn back off again. Note that because of system behavior, some vehicles must be driven a short distance before the sensors recognize the increase in pressure and turns the light off again. Pontiac Vibe Only: Do not use the TPMS reset button to turn off the light. The system will update and light will turn off when all tire pressures have been adjusted followed by short distance drive. Important: All models (except the Pontiac Vibe): Each tire monitor sensor is learned to a specific vehicle corner. When performing a TPM relearn (only after a tire rotation or replacement of a TPM sensor or Module), always use the Tech2(R) to initiate the J 46079 relearned process. Tech 2(R) - initiated relearns lock out other vehicle TPM signals that may be broadcasting in the area. Only signals initiated by the J 46079 tool will be accepted. This method avoids storing false TPM I.D.s and will prevent customers from returning with dashes (--) displayed in tire pressure readouts and/or a flashing tire pressure monitor (TPM) light. Checking the four TPM I.D.s with the Tech 2(R) prior to and following relearn to verify they are the same can prevent invalid I.D. learns. Pontiac Vibe Only: Tire Monitor Sensors are not learned to a specific vehicle corner. Do not perform a TPM Reset after tire rotation. The TPMS Reset button must only be used during pre-delivery inspection by the dealer to initialize the system (after all tire pressures have been adjusted properly) or when a Tire Pressure Monitor System component is replaced. The J 46079 tool does not work on Vibe TPM sensors. A TPMS relearn on Vibe must be preformed with a Tech 2(R) to set the TPMS Module in learn mode. The TPMS sensor IDs are entered through the Tech 2(R). Refer to SI for further Vibe TPMS information. Labor Operation and Repair Order/Warranty System Claim Required Documentation Important: The ONLY time labor operation E0726 or E0722 should be used is to diagnose for a system issue. That should ONLY occur if, at key ON, without starting the engine, the Tire Pressure Monitor (TPM) blinks for one minute and then stays on solid with a Service Tire Monitor System message (on vehicles equipped with a DIC) If that occurs, a TPM system problem exists and the system will have set a DTC. If one of these operastions is used, the following Repair Order and Warranty System documentation are required: ^ Document the customer complaint on the Repair Order. ^ Document the TPMS DTC that has set on the Repair Order. ^ Enter the TPMS DTC in the Warranty System (WINS) in the Failure Code/DTC field on the claim submission (refer to the Claims Processing Manual, Section IV, Warranty claim Data, Page 6, Item G). If the above information is not documented on the Repair Order and Warranty System, the claim may be rejected. If the Warranty Parts Center (WPC) generates a request, this repair order documentation must be sent back. Underhood Electrical Center or Junction Block Replacement Fuse Block: Service and Repair Underhood Electrical Center or Junction Block Replacement UNDERHOOD ELECTRICAL CENTER OR JUNCTION BLOCK REPLACEMENT REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Press tabs (1) inward and lift to remove the junction block cover. 3. Pull upward on the fuse relay center cover (1) to release the retaining tabs and remove the cover. 4. Note the location and remove the harness end bolts (2) and remove the harness ends from the fuse relay center. 5. Remove the fuse relay center bolts (3) and remove the fuse relay center from the junction block bracket. 6. Pull downward on the wiring harness ends to remove from the bottom of the fuse relay center. Page 7679 View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. 4. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers CIRCUIT PROTECTION - CIRCUIT BREAKERS A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types of circuit Description and Operation Electronic Throttle Actuator: Description and Operation Throttle Actuator Control (TAC) System Description Purpose The throttle actuator control (TAC) system delivers improved throttle response and greater reliability and eliminates the need for mechanical cable. The TAC system performs the following functions: * Accelerator pedal position sensing * Throttle positioning to meet driver and engine demands * Throttle position sensing * Internal diagnostics * Cruise control functions * Manage TAC electrical power consumption The TAC system includes the following components: * The accelerator pedal position (APP) sensors * The throttle body assembly * The engine control module (ECM) Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor The accelerator pedal contains 2 individual accelerator pedal position (APP) sensors within the assembly. The APP sensors 1 and 2 are potentiometer type sensors each with 3 circuits: * A 5-volt reference circuit * A low reference circuit * A signal circuit The APP sensors are used to determine the pedal angle. The engine control module (ECM) provides each APP sensor a 5-volt reference circuit and a low reference circuit. The APP sensors provide the ECM with signal voltage proportional to the pedal movement. The APP sensor 1 signal voltage at rest position is near 1 volt and increases to above 4 volts as the pedal is actuated. The APP sensor 2 signal voltage at rest position is near 1 volt and increases to more than 4 volts as the pedal is actuated. Throttle Body Assembly The throttle assembly contains the following components: * The throttle blade * The throttle actuator motor * The throttle position (TP) sensor 1 and 2 The throttle body functions similar to a conventional throttle body with the following exceptions: * An electric motor opens and closes the throttle valve. * The throttle blade is spring loaded in both directions and the default position is slightly open. * There are 2 individual TP sensors within the throttle body assembly. The TP sensors are used to determine the throttle plate angle. The TP sensors provide the engine control module (ECM) with a signal voltage proportional to throttle plate movement. The TP sensor 1 signal voltage at closed throttle is above 4 volts and decreases as the throttle plate is opened. The TP sensor 2 signal voltage at closed throttle is below 1 volt and increases as the throttle plate is opened. Engine Control Module The engine control module (ECM) is the control center for the throttle actuator control (TAC) system. The ECM determines the driver intent and then calculates the appropriate throttle response. The ECM achieves throttle positioning by providing a pulse width modulated voltage to the TAC motor. Modes of Operation Normal Mode During the operation of the throttle actuator control (TAC) system, several modes or functions are considered normal. The following modes may be entered during normal operation: Page 1532 7. Wrap electrical tape around the connection as shown. 8. Route the engine coolant heater cord and extension cord behind the alternator and adjacent to the engine coolant crossover pipe as shown. 9. Continue to route the extension cord to the exit location desired by the customer as shown. 10. Review the routing of the coolant heater cord and extension cord to verify that it does not touch any sharp edges that could damage it. 11. Secure the engine coolant heater cord and the extension cord with tie straps as needed. 12. Resecure any of the original clips that retained the engine coolant heater cord to the vehicle that were released to provide length. Part Information The extension cord may be obtained at any of the following outlets: - Lowes* - Home Depot* - Canada: Acklands-Grainger* (www.acklandsgrainger.com), Catalogue Part Number: CWRSJTOW3C14-10 USA: Cords should bear the UL symbol. Canada: Cords should bear the ULc symbol or CSA approval. *We believe these sources and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume any responsibility for the products or material from these firms or for any such items that may be available from other sources. Page 2872 1. Ignition OFF, relieve the fuel pressure. Refer to Fuel Pressure Relief. 2. Install the J37287 between the fuel feed pipe and the fuel rail. 3. Open the valve on the J37287. 4. Ignition ON, command the fuel pump relay ON with a scan tool and bleed the air from the fuel pressure gage. 5. Close the valve on the J37287. 6. Verify that the fuel pressure does not decrease more than 34 kPa (5 psi) in 1 minute. ‹› If the fuel pressure drops, locate and replace the leaking fuel injector. 7. If the fuel system test normal, replace the fuel pump. * Relieve the fuel pressure to 69 kPa (10 psi). Verify that the fuel pressure does not decrease more than 14 kPa (2 psi) in 5 minutes. ‹› If the fuel pressure decreases more than the specified value, replace the fuel pump. * Remove the J37287 and J34730-1A. * Operate the vehicle within the conditions of the customers concern while monitoring the fuel trim and O2 parameters with a scan tool. The scan tool parameters should not indicate a lean condition. ‹› If the scan tool parameters indicate a lean condition, test for a restricted fuel feed pipe, restricted fuel filter, or poor connections at the harness connectors and ground circuits of the fuel pump. If all test normal, replace the fuel pump. * If the fuel system components test normal, refer to Symptoms - Engine Controls. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures/Symptoms - Engine Controls Repair Instructions Perform the Diagnostic Repair Verification after completing the diagnostic procedure. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests and Procedures * Fuel Injector Replacement * Fuel Sender Assembly Replacement Page 1753 MOLEX CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. 2. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. Page 6321 5. Insert the J 38125-557 (GM P/N 12122378) into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 6. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Connector Position Assurance Locks CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of the connector. CPAs are used in various connectors throughout the vehicle. CPAs are also used in all SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals, of the connector. Connector Repairs CONNECTOR REPAIRS Page 8980 6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias. Reference the appropriate service manual wiring schematic to obtain the correct diode installation position. 7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for the soldering equipment. 8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed. 9. IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode attachment points with tape. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape. Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable SPLICING TWISTED OR SHIELDED CABLE Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable. 1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splice is made. 3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire. Staggering the splices by 65 mm (2.5 in) is recommended. 4. IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical contact with the drain wire. Re-assemble the cable. Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape. - Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1). - Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire. - Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape. Page 8930 The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors. 1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position. 4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool J 38125-10A (GM P/N 12014012-1) into the front (mating end) of the connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal through the back of the connector (2). IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector. 6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. 7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily. 10. Perform system check. Delphi Connectors (12 Way) DELPHI CONNECTORS (12-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. Page 2070 Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Service and Repair Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure Notice: Handle the electronic throttle control components carefully. Use cleanliness in order to prevent damage. Do not drop the electronic throttle control components. Do not roughly handle the electronic throttle control components. Do not immerse the electronic throttle control components in cleaning solvents of any type. 1. Disconnect the accelerator pedal position (APP) sensor electrical connector. 2. Remove the 3 APP sensor bolts (1). 3. Remove the APP sensor (2). Installation Procedure 1. Install the APP sensor. Page 4879 Diagram Information and Instructions Throttle Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions Electrical Symbols Page 8352 7. Wrap electrical tape around the connection as shown. 8. Route the engine coolant heater cord and extension cord behind the alternator and adjacent to the engine coolant crossover pipe as shown. 9. Continue to route the extension cord to the exit location desired by the customer as shown. 10. Review the routing of the coolant heater cord and extension cord to verify that it does not touch any sharp edges that could damage it. 11. Secure the engine coolant heater cord and the extension cord with tie straps as needed. 12. Resecure any of the original clips that retained the engine coolant heater cord to the vehicle that were released to provide length. Part Information The extension cord may be obtained at any of the following outlets: - Lowes* - Home Depot* - Canada: Acklands-Grainger* (www.acklandsgrainger.com), Catalogue Part Number: CWRSJTOW3C14-10 USA: Cords should bear the UL symbol. Canada: Cords should bear the ULc symbol or CSA approval. *We believe these sources and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume any responsibility for the products or material from these firms or for any such items that may be available from other sources. Page 8786 Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. For connectors with a bolt in the dress cover, turn the bolt counterclockwise to remove the connector from the component. 2. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. Page 5546 Connector Anatomy Connector Repairs contains a list of all connector repairs. The connector repairs are listed by the connector manufacturer and then by connector type. If the technician cannot identify the manufacturer of the connector, refer to Identifying Connectors below. Knowing the connector manufacturer will assist in finding the correct connector repair from the following list: - Connector Position Assurance Locks - Terminal Position Assurance Locks - Bosch Connectors (0.64) Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) Bosch Connectors (BSK) Bosch Connectors (ECM) - Delphi Connectors (Micro.64) Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) Delphi Connectors (12-Way) - Tyco/AMP Connectors (CM 42-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) Tyco/AMP Connectors (025 Cap) Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) - Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) - Repairing Connector Terminals IDENTIFYING CONNECTORS Knowing the connector manufacturer is helpful when trying to locating the correct connector repair procedure. There are many different connector designs used on GM vehicles and it is sometimes difficult to identify the connector manufacturer. The information in this document should help with the identification of connector manufactures. The following connector manufacturers make most of the connectors found in GM vehicles: AFL/EPC (Alcoa Fujikura Ltd./Engineered Plastics Components) - Bosch - Delphi - FCI (Framatome Connectors International) - JAE (Japan Aviation Electronics) - JST (Japan Solderless Terminals) Page 202 - JST connectors have JST in small letters on their connectors, similar to that above. The location of the logo will vary with the connector size and style. - Kostel has an "LK" with a circle around it. These connector are usually used as a transmissions connection and are currently use on some Cadillac vehicles. Page 6668 3. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. View showing depressing of the lever lock release tab. Page 475 Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested: - Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. - Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a component or to other harnesses. - If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A TEST LAMP TOOLS REQUIRED J 35616-200 Test Light - Probe Kit NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminate even though voltage is present. The J 35616-200 is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair of leads. To properly operate this tool use the following procedures. When testing for voltage: 1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested. When testing for ground: 1. Attach one lead to battery positive voltage. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where ground should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is ground at the point being tested. Using Connector Test Adapters USING CONNECTOR TEST ADAPTERS NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Using Fused Jumper Wires USING FUSED JUMPER WIRES TOOLS REQUIRED J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged. The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested. AFL/ECP Connectors AFL/EPC CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 1393 11. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 12. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 13. Center the high temperature SCT1 shrink tube over the DuraSeal splice sleeve. 14. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the high temperature heat shrink tubing. 15. Gradually move the heat from the center to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 16. Replace any reflective tape and clips that may have been remove during the repair. Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation REPAIRING DAMAGED WIRE INSULATION Wire Size Conversion Page 3926 7. Connect the integral clip (3) to the wire harness bracket. 8. Connect the fuel feed (1) and fuel return (2) pipes to the fuel rail. Refer to Metal Collar Quick Connect Fitting Service. 9. Connect the ECT sensor electrical connector (1). 10. Install the PCM mounting studs (5) to the intake manifold. Tighten the studs to 6 N.m (53 lb in). 11. Install the PCM (1) onto the studs (5). 12. Install the PCM retaining bolts (3). Tighten the bolts to 8 N.m (71 lb in). 13. Install the PCM retaining nuts (6). Knock Sensor Replacement (Left Side) Knock Sensor: Service and Repair Knock Sensor Replacement (Left Side) Knock Sensor Replacement (Left Side) Removal Procedure 1. Remove the mounting bolt for the knock sensor 1. 2. Disconnect the electrical connector of the knock sensor from the engine harness (3). 3. Remove the knock sensor (2) from the engine block (4). Installation Procedure 1. Reconnect the engine harness (3) and the knock sensor (2) electrical connectors. 2. Position the knock sensor 2 on the engine block (4). 3. Install the mounting bolt (1) for the knock sensor 2. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 4. Tighten the knock sensor mounting bolt (1). Tighten the knock sensor mounting bolt to 20 N.m (15 lb ft). Page 7805 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. 4. Remove the dress cover by using a flat bladed tool to release the dress cover locking tabs and lift up on the dress cover. 5. Cut the tie wrap that holds the wires to the connector body. Page 6652 Utility/Van Zoning UTILITY/VAN ZONING Page 7931 For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 176 Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Page 1011 Steering Mounted Controls Assembly: Diagrams Secondary/Configurable Control Connector End Views Steering Wheel Control Switch Assembly - Lower Left (STW) Steering Wheel Controls - Right (UK3) Steering Wheel Control Switch Assembly - Lower Right (STW) Page 3071 1. Install the radiator outlet hose to the engine (5). 2. Using J 38185 reposition the radiator outlet hose clamp (3). 3. Install the radiator outlet hose (2) to the radiator (1). 4. Using J 38185 reposition the radiator outlet hose clamp (3). 5. Lower the vehicle. 6. Fill the cooling system. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System (LL8) Draining and Filling Cooling System (LH6, LS2). Page 8542 4. Once the front 2 locks are unlocked, lift the front of the dress cover and pull it forward. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the small slot on the TPA and pushing down until the TPA releases. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to angle or rock the J 38125-21 tool when inserting it into the connector or the tool may break. Insert the J 38125-21 (GM P/N 15381651-2) tool into the round canal between the terminals cavities at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to repair Micro 64 connector terminals. The Micro 64 connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-64 (M jaw) was developed to crimp Micro 64 terminals. The J 38125-64 crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. The J 38125-64 crimping tool is also designed to crimp both the wire and the insulation at the same time. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro 64 terminals. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. 1. Cut the wire as close to the damaged terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. Page 4233 5. Remove the bolts (231) and timing chain tensioner (232). 6. Use the J 41816-2 (1), the J 41558 (2), bolts (3), and the J 8433 (4) in order to remove the crankshaft sprocket. Page 4760 1. Install the radiator outlet hose to the engine (5). 2. Using J 38185 reposition the radiator outlet hose clamp (3). 3. Install the radiator outlet hose (2) to the radiator (1). 4. Using J 38185 reposition the radiator outlet hose clamp (3). 5. Lower the vehicle. 6. Fill the cooling system. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System (LL8) Draining and Filling Cooling System (LH6, LS2). Page 5794 Utility/Van Zoning UTILITY/VAN ZONING Page 5311 - In some cases Delphi will actually be printed on the connector. If Delphi is not printed on the connector, look for PED. In both cases there is no specific orientation for Delphi or PED and they can appear anywhere on the connector. - FCI connectors may have the FCI logo on their connectors. The logo is the letters FCI with an "A" above it. - JAE connector have JAE in small letters on their connectors. Page 8388 Release the tabs that are holding the wiredress cover to the connector body. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the slots on both ends of the connector body. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. J 38125-216 can also be used to remove the nose piece. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by lifting the terminal retaining tabs on the inside of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 2905 1. Relieve the fuel system pressure, if required. Perform the following steps: Caution: Wrap a shop towel around the fuel pressure connection in order to reduce the risk of fire and personal injury. The towel will absorb any fuel leakage that occurs during the connection of the fuel pressure gage. Place the towel in an approved container when the connection of the fuel pressure gage is complete. 1. Wrap a shop towel around the fuel rail service port. 2. Place the hose on the CH-48027-2 (2) into an approved gasoline container. 3. Open the valve on the CH-48027-2 (2) in order to bleed any fuel from the fuel rail. 4. Close the valve on the CH-48027-2 (2). 5. Remove the hose on the CH-48027-2 (2) from the approved gasoline container. 6. Remove the shop towel from around the fuel rail service port, and place in an approved gasoline container. Notice: Clean all of the following areas before performing any disconnections in order to avoid possible contamination in the system: * The fuel pipe connections * The hose connections * The areas surrounding the connections Disconnect the CH-48027-1 (1) from the CH-48027-2 (2). 2. Disconnect the CH-48027-2 (2) from the CH-48027-3 (4). 3. Disconnect the CH-48027-3 (4) from the fuel rail service port. 4. Install the fuel rail service port cap. 5. Tighten the fuel fill cap. Page 8771 Utility/Van Zoning UTILITY/VAN ZONING Page 2596 TERMINAL REMOVAL Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors. 1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA) device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1). 3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 4. Gently pull the cable and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector. 5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal, refer to Terminal Repair. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3. Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector. REINSTALLING TERMINAL 1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly, refer to Wiring Repairs. 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3. Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) DELPHI CONNECTORS (WEATHER PACK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Service and Repair Power Mirror Switch: Service and Repair POWER MIRROR SWITCH REPLACEMENT REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Carefully use a flat-bladed tool in order to release the outside mirror switch retaining tabs from the trim panel. 2. Remove the outside mirror switch from the trim panel. 3. Disconnect the electrical connector from the power folding mirror switch. INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 1. Connect the electrical connector to the power folding mirror switch. 2. Position the power folding mirror switch to the door trim panel. 3. Apply downward pressure to the power folding mirror switch, ensuring the retaining tabs are fully seated. Page 5976 TERMINAL REMOVAL Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors. 1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA) device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1). 3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 4. Gently pull the cable and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector. 5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal, refer to Terminal Repair. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3. Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector. REINSTALLING TERMINAL 1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly, refer to Wiring Repairs. 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3. Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) DELPHI CONNECTORS (WEATHER PACK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 4358 Page 7640 pulling it through. This will prevent damage to the internal seals of the connector. Once the terminal is pushed out of the connector, cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible and pull the wire through the connector. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE The Micro-Pack 100W connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool was developed to crimp Micro-Pack 100W terminals. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 2. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert the terminal into the crimp tool until the core wings are flush with the anvil on the crimp tool. Be sure that the wings are pointed toward the crimp tool former and release the spring locator. The locator will hold the terminal in place. Inspect the alignment of the terminal wings with the crimp tool former. If the terminal wings are wider than the crimp tool former, remove the terminal and bend the terminal wings in slightly. 5. Place stripped wire into terminal. 6. Crimp the new terminal to the wire. If a jam occurs, press the emergency release to open applicator. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire perform the following procedure in order to replace Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. Page 286 Memory Positioning Module: Diagrams Memory Seat Module - Driver C4 Memory Seat Module - Driver C4 (w/Memory) Locations Headlamp Switch Page 6366 6. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by pressing on the tang. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (SENSOR) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) tool into the cavity on the lower right hand face of the connector until the terminal release tang access panel slides over. Cooling System - Inspecting Radiator/Heater Hose Clamps Radiator Hose: Technical Service Bulletins Cooling System - Inspecting Radiator/Heater Hose Clamps INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 06-06-02-014B Date: June 13, 2008 Subject: Inspecting Radiator and Heater Hose Clamps and Seals for Leaks During Pre-Delivery Inspection (PDI) Models: 2007 Buick Rainier 2007-2009 Chevrolet TrailBlazer, TrailBlazer SS 2007-2009 GMC Envoy 2007-2009 Saab 9-7X Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2009 model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 06-06-02-014A (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). The purpose of this bulletin is to inform dealers of required inspection of underhood and under vehicle radiator and heater hose clamps and seals for leaks and/or seepage during pre-delivery inspection (PDI). Field feedback indicates that some customers may notice engine coolant leaks shortly after delivery, which may result in an immediate decline of customer satisfaction with their new vehicle purchase. When performing a PDI on a vehicle listed in the models affected above, pay specific attention to the effectiveness of the engine coolant hose seal locations. Reposition/reclamp or replace the clamp to effect a proper system seal prior to customer delivery. Locations to Inspect During PDI Dealership personnel should examine the following locations closely during PDI (4.2L LL8 application shown in graphics below; refer to SI for specific information on 5.3L LH6 and 6.0L LS2):L LH6 and 6.0L LS2): 1. Radiator inlet hose (upper hose) to radiator (1). 2. Radiator inlet hose (upper hose) to engine (2). Page 879 7. Pressing the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool in the release cavity of the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and crimper in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (DOOR MODULE) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Side view of connector. View of top of connector. 1. Locate the assist lever and lock on the top of the connector. Page 4692 under pressure if the radiator cap or the surge tank cap is removed while the engine and radiator are still hot. 4. Remove the surge tank fill cap from the surge tank or the coolant pressure cap from the radiator. 5. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle in SI. 6. Place a clean drain pan under the radiator drain cock or under the lower radiator hose depending on the vehicle. Refer to Cooling System Draining and Filling in SI. 7. Loosen the radiator drain cock if equipped or use J 38185 clamp pliers and reposition the clamp on the lower radiator hose at the radiator. 8. Remove the end of the lower radiator hose from the radiator. 9. Drain the engine coolant sufficiently below the level of the ECT sensor. 10. Close the radiator drain cock or connect the lower radiator hose at the radiator. 11. Use the J 38185 clamp pliers to place the clamp into the original position on the hose. 12. Lower the vehicle. 13. Disconnect the wiring harness connector from the ECT sensor (2). 14. Remove the ECT sensor (1) from the front of the cylinder head. 15. Remove the corresponding size plug at the rear of the OTHER cylinder head. 16. Coat the threads of the ECT sensor with sealer. Use GM P/N 12346004 (Canadian P/N 10953480) or an equivalent. 17. Install the ECT sensor in the hole of the cylinder head where the plug was removed. Tighten Tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb ft). 18. Coat the threads of the plug with sealer. Use GM P/N 12346004 (Canadian P/N 10953480) or an equivalent. 19. Install the plug in the hole of the cylinder head where the ECT sensor was removed Tighten Tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb ft). Important Leave enough wire attached to the ECT sensor harness connector in order to create manageable splices that are at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splice. Page 5501 US English/Metric Conversion US English/Metric Conversion Page 6699 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the TPA. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the nose piece. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. Page 659 Disclaimer Page 5542 IMPORTANT: Ensure that the dress cover and connector body are both in the released position before reassembling. Failure to do so may cause damage to the connector and component. Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (0.64) BOSCH CONNECTORS (0.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While pressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock until the lever is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Pull the rubber boot that covers the wires back to expose the end of the connector dress cover. 4. Place the connector locking lever in the center of the connector. 5. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs that are on the wire end of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover and connector body and pry up. Locations Wiper Switch: Locations Windshield Wiper/Washer Switch Page 5009 Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Install the ECT sensor. Tighten the sensor to 20 N.m (15 lb ft). 3. Connect the ECT sensor electrical connector (1). 4. Refill the engine coolant. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System (LL8) Draining and Filling Cooling System (LH6, LS2). Page 2126 TERMINAL REMOVAL Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors. 1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA) device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1). 3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 4. Gently pull the cable and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector. 5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal, refer to Terminal Repair. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3. Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector. REINSTALLING TERMINAL 1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly, refer to Wiring Repairs. 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3. Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) DELPHI CONNECTORS (WEATHER PACK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 653 Remove all rust from the ground terminal, the cylinder head and the retaining nut or bolt. Position the main engine wiring harness ground terminal and install the nut or bolt. Tighten: Tighten the retaining nut or bolt to 16 N.m (12 lb ft). Apply some type of electrical moisture sealant to protect the harness terminal from further corrosion. Disclaimer Page 5466 8. Insert the J 38125-213 into the small terminal release hole on the nose piece and gently pull on the back of the wire. 9. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Repairing Connector Terminals REPAIRING CONNECTOR TERMINALS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following: Push to Seat terminals - Pull to Seat terminals Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your terminal repair. The J-38125 contains further information. 1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.For cable seal terminals, remove the seal. 2. Apply the correct cable seal per gage size of the wire, if used.Slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation removal. 3. Remove the insulation. 4. For sealed terminals only, align the seal with the end of the cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal.For sealed terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal. 6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.For sealed terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable. 8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals excepting Micro-Pack 100.64 size. Soldering Micro-Pack 100 World terminals may damage the terminal. Sumitomo Connectors SUMITOMO CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 8051 3. Ensure that the terminal release tang access panel is in the correct location to access the terminals. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) into the terminal release tang access slot located behind the access panel of the connector and press down on the terminal while carefully pulling the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Tyco/AMP Connectors (0.25 Cap) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (025 CAP) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component by pressing down on the connector position assurance (CPA). Page 6472 9. The illustration shows a cutaway view of the connector to aid the technician in releasing the terminal retainer. 10. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Terminal Position Assurance Locks TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Tyco/Amp Connectors (CM 42-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (CM 42-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the connector body and pull the CPA out. The CPA is on the wire harness side of connector. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 5992 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. 4. Remove the dress cover by using a flat bladed tool to release the dress cover locking tabs and lift up on the dress cover. 5. Cut the tie wrap that holds the wires to the connector body. Page 8066 11. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 12. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 13. Center the high temperature SCT1 shrink tube over the DuraSeal splice sleeve. 14. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the high temperature heat shrink tubing. 15. Gradually move the heat from the center to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 16. Replace any reflective tape and clips that may have been remove during the repair. Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation REPAIRING DAMAGED WIRE INSULATION Wire Size Conversion Page 2005 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) and slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. Page 5155 Refer to the following table as a guide in selecting the correct test adapter for front probing connectors: Backprobe IMPORTANT: Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures. - Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector. - Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large of a test probe. - After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected, test for proper terminal contact. Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the connector. Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure SCAN TOOL SNAPSHOT PROCEDURE Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used Page 2304 Page 250 6. Gently pry the plastic terminal retainer down and carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (16-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, pull the two connector halves apart. Page 8680 Depress the locks that are located on both sides of the wiredress cover and pull the lever over and past the locks. View of the connector when released from the component. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the front of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool push down on one of the locking tabs and pull the cover up until the dress cover releases. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. Page 8000 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. 4. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front of the connector. Page 1132 Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Specifications Temperature Versus Resistance Page 5406 All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system. Page 177 Checking Aftermarket Accessories CHECKING AFTERMARKET ACCESSORIES Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits: - CAUTION: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol. - NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice. OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol. Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the cause of the problems. Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include: Power feeds connected to points other than the battery - Antenna location - Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring - Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line - Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories. Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions INDUCING INTERMITTENT FAULT CONDITIONS TOOLS REQUIRED J 25070 Heat Gun Many intermittent open or shorted circuits are affected by harness/connector movement that is caused by vibration, engine torque, bumps/rough pavement, etc. In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness if the malfunction appears to be Page 4314 Water Pump: Service and Repair WATER PUMP REPLACEMENT Tools Required J 38185 Hose Clamp Pliers Removal Procedure 1. Drain the cooling system. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System (LL8) Draining and Filling Cooling System (LH6, LS2). 2. Loosen the air cleaner outlet duct clamps at the following locations: ^ Throttle body ^ Mass air flow (MAF)/intake air temperature (IAT) sensor 3. Remove the air cleaner outlet duct bolt and duct. 4. Remove the accessory drive belt tensioner. Refer to Drive Belt Tensioner Replacement - Accessory for the 5.3L engine or Drive Belt Tensioner Replacement - Accessory for the 6.0L engine. 5. Remove the cooing fan and shroud. Refer to Cooling Fan and Shroud Replacement. 6. Using the J 38185, reposition the inlet hose clamp at the water pump. Page 8089 Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Engine Control Module Replacement Service of the engine control module (ECM) should consist of either replacement of the ECM or programming of the electrically erasable programmable read only memory (EEPROM). If the diagnostic procedures call for the ECM to be replaced, the replacement ECM should be checked to ensure that the correct part is being used. If the correct part is being used, remove the faulty ECM and install the new service ECM. The replacement ECM must be programmed. Notice: * Turn the ignition OFF when installing or removing the control module connectors and disconnecting or reconnecting the power to the control module (battery cable, powertrain control module (PCM)/engine control module (ECM)/transaxle control module (TCM) pigtail, control module fuse, jumper cables, etc.) in order to prevent internal control module damage. * Control module damage may result when the metal case contacts battery voltage. DO NOT contact the control module metal case with battery voltage when servicing a control module, using battery booster cables, or when charging the vehicle battery. * In order to prevent any possible electrostatic discharge damage to the control module, do no touch the connector pins or the soldered components on the circuit board. * Remove any debris from around the control module connector surfaces before servicing the control module. Inspect the control module connector gaskets when diagnosing or replacing the control module. Ensure that the gaskets are installed correctly. The gaskets prevent contaminant intrusion into the control module. * The replacement control module must be programmed. Important: It is necessary to record the remaining engine oil life. If the replacement module is not programed with the remaining engine oil life, the engine oil life will default to 100 percent. If the replacement module is not programmed with the remaining engine oil life, the engine oil will need to be changed at 5 000 km (3,000 mi) from the last engine oil change. Removal Procedure 1. Using a scan tool, retrieve the percentage of remaining engine oil. Record the remaining engine oil life. 2. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 3. Disconnect the cooling fan electrical connector for additional clearance while removing the ECM. 4. Squeeze the ECM/transmission control module (TCM) cover upper retainers (1) in. 5. Remove the ECM/TCM cover. Page 6522 Page 2183 Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair Mass Airflow Sensor/Intake Air Temperature Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure Important: Use care when handling the mass air flow (MAF)/intake air temperature (IAT) sensor. Do not dent, puncture, or otherwise damage the honeycell located at the air inlet end of the MAF/IAT. Do not touch the sensing elements or allow anything including cleaning solvents and lubricants to come in contact with them. Use a small amount of a non-silicone based lubricant, on the air duct only, to aid in installation. 1. Disconnect the MAF/IAT sensor electrical connector. 2. Loosen the clamps at the MAF/IAT sensor and the throttle body. 3. Remove the air cleaner outlet duct bolt. 4. Remove the air cleaner outlet duct. 5. Loosen the clamp attaching the MAF/IAT sensor to the air cleaner housing. 6. Remove the MAF/IAT sensor from the air cleaner housing. Installation Procedure Important: The embossed arrow on the MAF/IAT sensor indicates the proper air flow direction. The arrow must point toward the engine. Page 2752 Tire Pressure Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Tire Monitor System - TPM Sensor Information INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 08-03-16-003 Date: May 12, 2008 Subject: Warranty Reduction - Transfer of Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensors to Replacement Wheels and Allowable TPM Sensor Replacements Models: 2000-2009 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2003-2009 HUMMER H2 2006-2009 HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7x with On-Wheel TPM Sensors TPM Sensor / Wheel Warranty Reviews During the last warranty review period it was noted that wheels being returned under the GM New Vehicle Warranty were being shipped back to General Motors with the TPM sensor still attached to the wheel. Return rates ran as high as 60% with the TPM sensors still attached. Operational TPM sensors should not be returned to GM and are to be transferred to replacement wheels if they become necessary. Important: Operational TPM Sensors that are returned under warranty to General Motors will be charged back to the dealer.Sensors have a 10 year /150,000 mile (240,000 km) battery life, and should be transferred if one or more wheels are replaced. TPM Valve Stem / Grommet (0-ring) Replacement When the TPM sensors are transferred to new wheels you should replace the component used to seal the TPM sensor stem to the wheel. On sensors with an aluminum stem and visible nut on the outside of the wheel a replacement grommet (0-ring) should be used to assure a proper seal. The sensor retaining nut (except Aveo) should be tightened to 7 N.m (62 lb in) for all vehicles except Pontiac Vibe (4.0 N.m (35.4 lb in)). Important: ^ DO NOT overtorque the retaining nut. Notice: ^ Factory installed TPM Sensors come with plastic aluminum or nickel-plated brass stem caps. These caps should not be changed. Chrome plated steel caps may cause corrosion of aluminum valve stems due to incompatibility of the metals. On current style sensors the entire rubber stem is replaceable. The service interval on the revised TPM sensor with replaceable stem is the same as for any other traditional valve stem. Replace the stem at the time of tire replacement sensor transfer or whenever air seepage is suspected at the valve stem. When replacing the valve stem tighten the screw to 1.3 N.m (11.5 lb in). For either style of TPM sensor see the service parts guide for the correct GM part numbers to order and use. Disclaimer Page 8468 Page 1604 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) and slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. Page 4882 Utility/Van Zoning UTILITY/VAN ZONING Page 2457 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert terminal into the appropriate terminal holder until it hits bottom and stops. The correct terminal holder is determined by the wire size. Also ensure that the terminals wings are pointing towards the former on the tool and the release locator. 5. Insert the stripped cable into the terminal. Insulation should be visible on both sides of the terminal insulation wings. 6. Compress the handles until the ratchet automatically releases. 7. Place the terminal into the appropriate cavity and assemble the connector. Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO-PACK 100W) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W connectors. These connectors are very similar but use different terminals and have some minor physical differences also. Page 8510 Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Page 8377 MEASURING FREQUENCY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal. IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM to autorange to an appropriate range. 1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency measured. Measuring Voltage MEASURING VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit. 1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods: - Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. - Turn ON the engine. - Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls. - Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested. 3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The DMM displays the voltage measured at that point. Measuring Voltage Drop MEASURING VOLTAGE DROP NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points. Probing Electrical Connectors PROBING ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS Page 1373 3. Use a small flat-bladed tool to gently pry off the dress cover by inserting the tool under the cover opposite the harness side and prying up. 4. Remove the cover. 5. Using a small flat-bladed tool, push on the side of the nose piece retainer while pushing the nose piece forward with your thumb. This will release the terminal position assurance (TPA). 6. Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) into the corresponding terminal release cavity. The release cavities are the 2 center rows of cavities on one half of the connector. Page 5718 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry one side of the nose piece up to the pre-stage position. When the nose piece is in the pre-staged position, the nose piece will be raised above the connector body the length of the step in the nose piece. 7. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry the other side of the piece to the pre-stage position. If the nose piece is higher than the first step in the nose piece, gently push down on the nose piece until it meets with resistance from the connector body, you should feel the nose piece click into position. Page 552 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link). - The wire insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. 5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold them between thumb and forefinger. 7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place. - Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction. - Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip. 8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool closes.Ensure that no strands of wire are cut. 10. Crimp the splice on each end (2). Service and Repair Engine Oil Control Valve: Service and Repair Oil Pressure Relief Valve Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Remove the oil pan. Refer to Oil Pan Replacement. 2. Remove the oil filter tube bolts (435, 446) and gaskets (445, 448). 3. Remove the oil filter tube (447). 4. Remove the displacement on demand oil pressure relief valve (455) by pushing downward. Installation Procedure Page 477 3. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. View showing depressing of the lever lock release tab. Page 2479 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. 4. Remove the dress cover by using a flat bladed tool to release the dress cover locking tabs and lift up on the dress cover. 5. Cut the tie wrap that holds the wires to the connector body. Page 894 If a wire is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm, etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except coaxial. - Do not use the DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent American wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 6161 Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Adjustments Park/Neutral Position Switch Adjustment Important: ^ The following procedure is for vehicles that have not had the switch removed or replaced. If the switch has been removed or replaced, refer to Park/Neutral Position Switch Replacement for the proper adjustment procedure. ^ Apply the parking brake. ^ The engine must start in the P (Park) or N (Neutral) positions only. ^ Check the switch for proper operation. If adjustment is required, proceed as follows: 1. Place the transmission range selector in the N (Neutral) position. 2. With an assistant in the drivers seat, raise the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 3. Loosen the park/neutral position switch mounting bolts. 4. With the vehicle in the N (Neutral) position, rotate the switch while the assistant attempts to start the engine. 5. Following a successful start, turn the engine OFF. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 6. Tighten the bolts securing the switch to the transmission. Tighten the bolts to 25 N.m (18 lb ft). 7. Lower the vehicle. 8. Check the switch for proper operation. The engine must start in the P (Park) or N (Neutral) positions only. 9. Replace the park/neutral position switch if proper operation can not be achieved. Refer to Park/Neutral Position Switch Replacement. Page 7557 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the DuraSeal splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of a connector. CPAs are used in all SIR System connectors and also in some connectors of other systems. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals of a connection. TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE CLIPS IMPORTANT: When making a splice in an area that may be exposed to moisture use a crimp and seal splice sleeve instead of a Splice Clip. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. Page 5312 - JST connectors have JST in small letters on their connectors, similar to that above. The location of the logo will vary with the connector size and style. - Kostel has an "LK" with a circle around it. These connector are usually used as a transmissions connection and are currently use on some Cadillac vehicles. Page 6955 Open the harness by removing any tape. 2. Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. 3. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 4. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent american wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 5. Slide a section of high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing down the length of wire to be spliced. Ensure that the shrink tubing will not interfere with the splice procedure. 6. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 7. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. 8. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 9. Insert the wire into the DuraSeal splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 10. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Diagrams Liftglass Ajar Switch OnStar(R) - Language Change Information Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Language Change Information Bulletin No.: 05-08-46-009B Date: June 29, 2007 INFORMATION Subject: Language Change for OnStar(R) System (U.S. and Canada Only) Models: 2006-2008 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2006-2008 HUMMER H2, H3 2006-2008 Saab 9-7X with OnStar(R) (RPO UE1) Built After and Including VIN Breakpoints Listed Below (2006 MY Only) Attention: This bulletin only applies to vehicles equipped with OnStar(R) Generation 6.1 or later with a Station Identification (STID) Number in the following range: 16,000,000-17,000,000 or 20,000,000-21,999,999 or 23,500,001-26,000,000 Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the service procedure and add a Canadian procedure. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Numbers 05-08-46-009A and 05-08-46-008A (Section 08 - Body and Accessories). Page 1848 Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested: - Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. - Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a component or to other harnesses. - If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A TEST LAMP TOOLS REQUIRED J 35616-200 Test Light - Probe Kit NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminate even though voltage is present. The J 35616-200 is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair of leads. To properly operate this tool use the following procedures. When testing for voltage: 1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested. When testing for ground: 1. Attach one lead to battery positive voltage. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where ground should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is ground at the point being tested. Using Connector Test Adapters USING CONNECTOR TEST ADAPTERS NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Using Fused Jumper Wires USING FUSED JUMPER WIRES TOOLS REQUIRED J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged. The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested. AFL/ECP Connectors AFL/EPC CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 7598 Locations Fuel Pump Relay: Locations Fuse Block - Underhood (5.3L/6.0L), Label Page 8788 View of connector in released position. 4. Disconnect the connector from the component. 5. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Release the rear lower half of the wiredress cover. Page 5488 If a wire is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm, etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except coaxial. - Do not use the DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent American wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 9011 to analyze the data during the time a vehicle condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a trigger point that you have determined. Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2 snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a first-in, first-out basis. If a third snapshot is taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost. Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types: Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice - Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200 frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not lost if the Scan Tool is powered down. The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis. The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected values by plotting 3 parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful, especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC. Testing for a Short to Voltage TESTING FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4. Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt, there is a short to voltage in the circuit. Testing for Continuity TESTING FOR CONTINUITY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6. Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit. 7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity. With a Test Lamp IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits. 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6. If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity. Testing for Electrical Intermittents TESTING FOR ELECTRICAL INTERMITTENTS Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment. - Testing for Short to Ground - Testing for Continuity - Testing for a Short to Voltage Page 7341 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (BSK) BOSCH CONNECTORS (BSK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 3. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 4. Insert the J 38125-561 tool into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 5. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is Page 7038 - Yazaki has a wedge or arrow shape, similar to that shown. Delphi Connectors (Micro .64) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro 64 connectors. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. The lever lock may be located on the top or sides of the wire dress cover. Page 4306 1. Correctly position the spark plug washer. 2. Inspect the spark plug gap. Adjust the gap as needed. Spark plug gap: 1.524 mm (0.06 in) 3. Hand start the spark plug in the corresponding cylinder. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 4. Tighten the spark plug. * For used heads, tighten the plug to 15 N.m (11 lb ft). * For NEW heads, tighten the plug to 20 N.m (15 lb ft). 5. Install the spark plug wire. 6. If removed, install the washer solvent container. Page 2705 For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 2586 View of a typical Micro 64 connector. Depress the lock and pull the lever over and past the lock. Page 847 4. Once the front 2 locks are unlocked, lift the front of the dress cover and pull it forward. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the small slot on the TPA and pushing down until the TPA releases. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to angle or rock the J 38125-21 tool when inserting it into the connector or the tool may break. Insert the J 38125-21 (GM P/N 15381651-2) tool into the round canal between the terminals cavities at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to repair Micro 64 connector terminals. The Micro 64 connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-64 (M jaw) was developed to crimp Micro 64 terminals. The J 38125-64 crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. The J 38125-64 crimping tool is also designed to crimp both the wire and the insulation at the same time. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro 64 terminals. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. 1. Cut the wire as close to the damaged terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. Engine - Intake Manifold Inspection/Replacement Intake Manifold: Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Intake Manifold Inspection/Replacement INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 00-06-01-026C Date: February 03, 2010 Subject: Intake Manifold Inspection/Replacement After Severe Internal Engine Damage Models: 2010 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to include additional model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 00-06-01-026B (Section 06 - Engine). When replacing an engine due to internal damage, extreme care should be taken when transferring the intake manifold to the new Goodwrench service engine long block. Internal damage may result in the potential discharge of internal engine component debris in the intake manifold via broken pistons and/or bent, broken, or missing intake valves. After removing the intake manifold from the engine, the technician should carefully inspect all of the cylinder head intake ports to see if the valve heads are still present and not bent. Usually when the valve heads are missing or sufficiently bent, internal engine component debris will be present to varying degrees in the intake port of the cylinder head. If this debris is present in any of the cylinder head intake ports, the intake manifold should be replaced. This replacement is required due to the complex inlet runner and plenum configuration of most of the intake manifolds, making thorough and complete component cleaning difficult and nearly impossible to verify complete removal of debris. Re-installation of an intake manifold removed from an engine with deposits of internal engine component debris may result in the ingestion of any remaining debris into the new Goodwrench service engine. This may cause damage or potential failure of the new service engine. Disclaimer Page 261 If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the DuraSeal splice sleeves. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: - Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. - Do not use the crimp and DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 to crimp DuraSeal splice sleeve. In order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 6380 The engine harness may be repaired using the J-38125. High Temperature Wiring Repairs HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperatures, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time may use materials i.e. wires, connectors, and shielding that has a higher heat rating than typical wiring. When making a repair in a high temperature area observe the following: Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature to replace any damaged wire. - Replace any heat shielding that is removed. - Cover any DuraSeal splice sleeves with SCT1 shrink tubing (available in the J-38125 Terminal Repair kit). - After making a wiring repair, ensure that the location of the wiring is not moved closer to the heat source. IDENTIFYING HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperature, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time need special considerations when making wiring repairs. Areas that may be exposed to higher temperatures can be identified by heat resistant materials that are being used in those areas. These materials may include heat reflective tape, moon tape, and high temperature shrink tubing. Also conduit and other protective coverings may be used. Because conduit or similar coverings are used throughout the vehicle regardless of the temperature, it may be necessary for the technician to determine if an area is exposed to excessive heat before making a wiring repair. Obvious areas of consideration would be any area located near the exhaust manifolds, catalytic converter, and exhaust pipes. The J-38125 contains much of the material you will need to perform repairs on areas exposed to high heat. The kit contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves to crimp and seal connections - High temperature SCT1 shrink tubing to protect the splice sleeves - A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct crimp tool to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools to remove the terminals from the connectors The J-38125 does not contain wire that is suitable to high temperature exposure. Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature of the same or larger gage size as the original wire when repair damage wire. Also replace any reflective tape that you remove during the repair. HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature rating of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125 and then encapsulate the splice sleeve using the high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the order listed. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip keeping all of the wire strands intact. Page 3573 onto the subject vehicle. - After match mounting, the tire/wheel assembly must be rebalanced. If match mounting tires to in-spec wheels produces assembly values higher than these, tire replacement may be necessary. Replacing tires at lower values will probably mean good tires are being condemned. Because tires can sometimes become temporarily flat-spotted, which will affect force variation, it is important that the vehicle be driven at least 16 km (10 mi) prior to measuring. Tire pressure must also be adjusted to the usage pressure on the vehicle's tire placard prior to measuring. Most GM vehicles will tolerate radial force variation up to these levels. However, some vehicles are more sensitive, and may require lower levels. Also, there are other tire parameters that equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700 cannot measure that may be a factor. In such cases, TAC should be contacted for further instructions. Important - When mounting a GM wheel to a wheel balancer/force variation machine, always use the wheel's center pilot hole. This is the primary centering mechanism on all GM wheels; the bolt holes are secondary. Usually a back cone method to the machine should be used. For added accuracy and repeatability, a flange plate should be used to clamp the wheel onto the cone and machine. This system is offered by all balancer manufacturers in GM's dealer program. - Any type of service equipment that removes tread rubber by grinding, buffing or truing is NOT recommended, and may void the tire warranty. However, tires may have been ground by the tire company as part of their tire manufacturing process. This is a legitimate procedure. Steering Wheel Shake Worksheet When diagnosing vibration concerns, use the following worksheet in conjunction with the appropriate Vibration Analysis-Road testing procedure in the Vibration Correction sub-section in SI. Page 6672 difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Bosch Connectors (ECM) BOSCH CONNECTORS (ECM) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the assist lever on the top of the connector. Move the assist lever to the forward position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 426 Release the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the blue locking tabs on both ends of the connector. Gently slide the TPA up to the released position on both ends. 6. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-13A (GM P/N 12031876-1) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. Page 8820 REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. The release tab is located on the top of the wiredress cover. View of connector in released position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Page 8035 4. Slide the dress cover forward and off of the connector. 5. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front and rear of the connector. Page 5677 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (BSK) BOSCH CONNECTORS (BSK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 3. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 4. Insert the J 38125-561 tool into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 5. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is Page 8062 If a wire is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm, etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except coaxial. - Do not use the DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent American wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 356 Checking Aftermarket Accessories CHECKING AFTERMARKET ACCESSORIES Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits: - CAUTION: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol. - NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice. OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol. Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the cause of the problems. Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include: Power feeds connected to points other than the battery - Antenna location - Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring - Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line - Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories. Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions INDUCING INTERMITTENT FAULT CONDITIONS TOOLS REQUIRED J 25070 Heat Gun Many intermittent open or shorted circuits are affected by harness/connector movement that is caused by vibration, engine torque, bumps/rough pavement, etc. In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness if the malfunction appears to be Page 1915 breakers are used. CIRCUIT BREAKER This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high current is removed. POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) CIRCUIT BREAKER This type greatly increases its resistance when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker will re-close within a second or 2. Circuit Protection - Fuses CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSES The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and examine the element in the fuse for an open (2). If not broken (1), also check for continuity using a DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one of equal current rating. Circuit Protection - Fusible Links CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSIBLE LINKS Page 6670 Release the tabs that are holding the wiredress cover to the connector body. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the slots on both ends of the connector body. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. J 38125-216 can also be used to remove the nose piece. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by lifting the terminal retaining tabs on the inside of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 3469 Fuse Block - Underhood C7 Page 4664 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Start in the middle and gradually move the heat barrel to the open ends of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Heated Oxygen Sensor Wiring Repairs HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being obstructed. If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. - Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks, etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire. - Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance. - To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector. Page 4459 Testing and Inspection Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Testing and Inspection Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) Diagnosis Diagnostic Fault Information Perform the Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle prior to using this diagnostic procedure. Circuit/System Description Ignition voltage is supplied to the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL). The engine control module (ECM) turns the MIL ON by grounding the MIL control circuit. Circuit/System Verification Ignition ON, the MIL should turn ON and OFF when commanded with a scan tool. Circuit/System Testing 1. Ignition OFF, disconnect the harness connector at the instrument panel cluster (IPC). 2. Ignition ON, verify that a test lamp illuminates between the ignition circuit and ground. ‹› If the test lamp does not illuminate, test the ignition circuit for a short to ground or an open/high resistance. If the circuit tests normal and the ignition circuit fuse is open, replace the IPC. 3. Connect a test lamp between the control circuit and the ignition circuit. 4. Command the MIL ON and OFF with a scan tool. The test lamp should turn ON and OFF when changing between the commanded states. ‹› If the test lamp is always ON, test the control circuit for a short to ground. If the circuit tests normal, replace the ECM. ‹› If the test lamp is always OFF, test the control circuit for a short to voltage or an open/high resistance. If the circuit tests normal, replace the ECM. 5. If all circuits test normal, replace the IPC. Repair Instructions Perform the Diagnostic Repair Verification after completing the diagnostic procedure. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests and Procedures * Control Module References See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning * Instrument Cluster Replacement Page 8121 Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Page 6675 IMPORTANT: Ensure that the dress cover and connector body are both in the released position before reassembling. Failure to do so may cause damage to the connector and component. Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (0.64) BOSCH CONNECTORS (0.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While pressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock until the lever is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Pull the rubber boot that covers the wires back to expose the end of the connector dress cover. 4. Place the connector locking lever in the center of the connector. 5. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs that are on the wire end of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover and connector body and pry up. Page 2511 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link). - The wire insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. 5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold them between thumb and forefinger. 7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place. - Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction. - Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip. 8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool closes.Ensure that no strands of wire are cut. 10. Crimp the splice on each end (2). Page 996 Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Diagrams Immobilizer Connector End Views Hood Ajar Switch (UA2) Page 5682 6. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs located on the opposite side of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover at the connector end and pry up. 7. Remove the dress cover. 8. Cut the tie wrap on the wire bundle. 9. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting a small flat-bladed tool into the small slot in the end of the slider and pushing on the TPA until it comes out of the connector. When the TPA exits the opposite side of the connector, gasp the TPA and pull it completely out of the connector. 10. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 4175 12. Remove the heater water shutoff valve actuator inlet hose from the intake manifold. 13. Remove the EVAP purge solenoid vent tubes (1, 2). Refer to Plastic Collar Quick Connect Fitting Service. Page 7817 6. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by pressing on the tang. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (SENSOR) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) tool into the cavity on the lower right hand face of the connector until the terminal release tang access panel slides over. Page 841 - JST connectors have JST in small letters on their connectors, similar to that above. The location of the logo will vary with the connector size and style. - Kostel has an "LK" with a circle around it. These connector are usually used as a transmissions connection and are currently use on some Cadillac vehicles. Page 1940 Oxygen Sensor: Service Precautions Heated Oxygen Sensor Resistance Learn Reset Notice Heated Oxygen Sensor Resistance Learn Reset Notice Notice: When replacing the HO2S perform the following: * A code clear with a scan tool, regardless of whether or not a DTC is set * HO2S heater resistance learn reset with a scan tool, where available Perform the above in order to reset the HO2S resistance learned value and avoid possible HO2S failure. Page 6680 - Kostel - Molex - Sumitomo - Tyco/AMP - Yazaki Identifying the manufacturer of a connector is often difficult. When trying to determine the manufacturer of a connector, look for specific identifying marks that are unique to that connector supplier. Most of these identify marks are hard to find or see. Check the connector carefully and refer to the information below for pictures and descriptions of connector identification markings. - Most of AFLs connectors have EPC on their connector body. Some of the smaller connectors will not have any markings on them. - In some cases Bosch will actually be printed on the connector. If Bosch does not appear on the connector, look for the Bosch logo. The Bosch logo is a circle with a blunted arrow inside. This logo can appear anywhere on the connector and is often very small. Page 1645 Open the harness by removing any tape. 2. Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. 3. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 4. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent american wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 5. Slide a section of high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing down the length of wire to be spliced. Ensure that the shrink tubing will not interfere with the splice procedure. 6. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 7. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. 8. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 9. Insert the wire into the DuraSeal splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 10. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Page 2324 View of connector in released position. 4. Disconnect the connector from the component. 5. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Release the rear lower half of the wiredress cover. Page 690 Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. For connectors with a bolt in the dress cover, turn the bolt counterclockwise to remove the connector from the component. 2. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. Page 1771 View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. View of the release tool being used for the smaller terminals. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (2-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 833 5. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove TPA from the connector. 6. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Page 1934 Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Bank 2 Sensor 1 Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Bank 2 Sensor 2 Page 1948 Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Heated Oxygen Sensor Replacement - Bank 2 Sensor 2 Heated Oxygen Sensor Replacement - Bank 2 Sensor 2 Removal Procedure 1. Raise and suitably support the vehicle. Refer to vehicle lifting. Notice: Refer to Heated Oxygen and Oxygen Sensor Notice. 2. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) retainer. 3. Disconnect the heated oxygen sensor (HO2S) electrical connector (1). Notice: Refer to Excessive Force and Oxygen Sensor Notice. 4. Remove the HO2S (2). Installation Procedure Important: A special anti-seize compound is used on the HO2S threads. The compound consists of liquid graphite and glass beads. The graphite tends to burn away, but the glass beads remain, making the sensor easier to remove. New, or service replacement sensors already have the compound applied to the threads. If the sensor is removed from an exhaust component and if for any reason the sensor is to be reinstalled, the threads must have anti-seize compound applied before the reinstallation. Page 1543 Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Specifications Temperature Versus Resistance Page 463 Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay: Diagnostic Aids Arrows and Symbols Arrows and Symbols This Service Data uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations. Arrows and Symbols 1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow Basic Knowledge Required GENERAL ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures contained in the service manual. You should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current (amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram, as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. Decimal and Metric Equivalents Decimal and Metric Equivalents Page 4310 Compression Check: Testing and Inspection Engine Compression Test 1. Charge the battery if the battery is not fully charged. 2. Disable the ignition system. 3. Disable the fuel injection system. 4. Remove all spark plugs. 5. Turn the ignition to the ON position. 6. Depress the accelerator pedal to position the throttle plate wide open. 7. Start with the compression gage at zero and crank the engine through 4 compression strokes, 4 puffs. 8. Measure the compression for each cylinder. Record the readings. 9. If a cylinder has low compression, inject approximately 15 ml (1 tablespoon) of engine oil into the combustion chamber through the spark plug hole. Measure the compression again and record the reading. 10. The minimum compression in any 1 cylinder should not be less than 70 percent of the highest cylinder. No cylinder should read less than 690 kPa (100 psi). For example, if the highest pressure in any 1 cylinder is 1 035 kPa (150 psi), the lowest allowable pressure for any other cylinder would be 725 kPa (105 psi). (1 035 x 70% = 725) (150 x 70% = 105). ^ Normal - Compression builds up quickly and evenly to the specified compression for each cylinder. ^ Piston Rings Leaking - Compression is low on the first stroke. Compression builds up with the following strokes, but does not reach normal. Compression improves considerably when you add oil. ^ Valves Leaking - Compression is low on the first stroke. Compression usually does not build up on the following strokes. Compression does not improve much when you add oil. ^ If 2 adjacent cylinders have lower than normal compression, and injecting oil into the cylinders does not increase the compression, the cause may be a head gasket leaking between the cylinders. Page 5392 Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Service and Repair Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure Notice: Handle the electronic throttle control components carefully. Use cleanliness in order to prevent damage. Do not drop the electronic throttle control components. Do not roughly handle the electronic throttle control components. Do not immerse the electronic throttle control components in cleaning solvents of any type. 1. Disconnect the accelerator pedal position (APP) sensor electrical connector. 2. Remove the 3 APP sensor bolts (1). 3. Remove the APP sensor (2). Installation Procedure 1. Install the APP sensor. Page 474 - A control module from another vehicle is installed. - Revised software/calibration files have been released for this vehicle. - IMPORTANT: DO NOT re-program the control module with the SAME software/calibration files that are already present in the control module. This is not an effective repair for any type of concern. Verify that the control module contains the correct software/calibration. If incorrect programming is found, reprogram the control module with the most current software/calibration. Refer to Control Module References for replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Testing for Short to Ground TESTING FOR SHORT TO GROUND NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 4. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit. With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is a short to ground in the circuit. Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2. Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). - When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. - If the DMM does not display voltage 4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is shorted. Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A DIGITAL MULTIMETER NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the powertrain control module (PCM), should only be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200 Digital Multimeter (DMM). The J 39200 instruction manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminage even though voltage is present. The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity. IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading. Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the measurement. Page 1210 Fuel Gauge Sender: Diagrams Displays and Gages Connector End Views Fuel Pump and Sender Assembly Page 1437 View of connector in released position. 4. Disconnect the connector from the component. 5. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Release the rear lower half of the wiredress cover. Page 2391 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Start in the middle and gradually move the heat barrel to the open ends of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Heated Oxygen Sensor Wiring Repairs HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being obstructed. If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. - Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks, etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire. - Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance. - To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector. Page 4464 Page 1845 If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200 DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J 39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected. IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J 39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and maximum (MAX) values measured. 1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of a suspected circuit to the other. 2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J 39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep). IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value in order to record the full change. 5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling the connections or the wiring, test driving, or performing other operations. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions. 6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9. Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist. Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections TESTING FOR INTERMITTENT CONDITIONS AND POOR CONNECTIONS TOOLS REQUIRED - J 35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit - J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit When the condition is not currently present, but is indicated in DTC history, the cause may be intermittent. An intermittent may also be the cause when there is a customer complaint, but the symptom cannot be duplicated. Refer to the Symptom Table of the system that is suspect of causing the condition before trying to locate an intermittent condition. Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the following items: Wiring broken inside the insulation - Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector - Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself, and corrosion in the wire to terminal contact area, etc. - Pierced or damaged insulation can allow moisture to enter the wiring causing corrosion. The conductor can corrode inside the insulation, with little visible evidence. Look for swollen and stiff sections of wire in the suspect circuits. - Wiring which has been pinched, cut, or its insulation rubbed through may cause an intermittent open or short as the bare area touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle. - Wiring that comes in contact with hot or exhaust components - Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required, in order to verify the customer concern. - Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. - Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis and Vehicle Data Recorder operation. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any inline connectors before replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation. Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination, usually in the underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit. Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper adapter. Always use the J 35616 when probing connectors. Other causes of terminal deformation are improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT IN BUSSED ELECTRICAL CENTERS (BEC) Page 8230 Page 1596 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert terminal into the appropriate terminal holder until it hits bottom and stops. The correct terminal holder is determined by the wire size. Also ensure that the terminals wings are pointing towards the former on the tool and the release locator. 5. Insert the stripped cable into the terminal. Insulation should be visible on both sides of the terminal insulation wings. 6. Compress the handles until the ratchet automatically releases. 7. Place the terminal into the appropriate cavity and assemble the connector. Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO-PACK 100W) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W connectors. These connectors are very similar but use different terminals and have some minor physical differences also. Page 3680 Do NOT attach the positive jumper cable to the stud located under the engine compartment fuse block cover. Doing so may blow the fuse resulting in various interior electrical system conditions. Disclaimer Diagram Information and Instructions Oxygen Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions Electrical Symbols Page 1396 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the DuraSeal splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of a connector. CPAs are used in all SIR System connectors and also in some connectors of other systems. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals of a connection. TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE CLIPS IMPORTANT: When making a splice in an area that may be exposed to moisture use a crimp and seal splice sleeve instead of a Splice Clip. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. Page 2093 to analyze the data during the time a vehicle condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a trigger point that you have determined. Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2 snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a first-in, first-out basis. If a third snapshot is taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost. Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types: Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice - Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200 frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not lost if the Scan Tool is powered down. The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis. The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected values by plotting 3 parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful, especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC. Testing for a Short to Voltage TESTING FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4. Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt, there is a short to voltage in the circuit. Testing for Continuity TESTING FOR CONTINUITY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6. Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit. 7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity. With a Test Lamp IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits. 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6. If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity. Testing for Electrical Intermittents TESTING FOR ELECTRICAL INTERMITTENTS Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment. - Testing for Short to Ground - Testing for Continuity - Testing for a Short to Voltage Page 8601 5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape. Seat Belt Schematic Icons Seat Belt Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons Page 8394 6. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs located on the opposite side of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover at the connector end and pry up. 7. Remove the dress cover. 8. Cut the tie wrap on the wire bundle. 9. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting a small flat-bladed tool into the small slot in the end of the slider and pushing on the TPA until it comes out of the connector. When the TPA exits the opposite side of the connector, gasp the TPA and pull it completely out of the connector. 10. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 2965 Disclaimer Page 255 If a wire is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm, etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except coaxial. - Do not use the DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent American wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 2165 Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size. REPAIRING A FUSIBLE LINK IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient overload protection. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. Flat Wire Repairs FLAT WIRE REPAIRS NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced. GMLAN Wiring Repairs GMLAN WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The GM Local Area Network (GMLAN) System requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working on GMLAN connectors and terminals. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items in order to repair the GMLAN wiring: Dura Seal splice sleeves - A wire stripping tool - J 38125-8 Crimping Tool (GM P/N 12085115) - J 38125-5 Ultra Torch Special Tool (GM P/N 12085116) The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. - A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors GMLAN REPAIRS IMPORTANT: When making a repair to any GMLAN network, the original wire length after the repair must be the same length as before the repair. If the network is a twisted pair, the twist must be maintained after the repair is completed. GMLAN has 2 types of networks, low speed and high speed. Low speed GMLAN has a single wire and works at slow speeds. High speed GMLAN has 2 wires in a twisted pair and works at higher speeds. For more information on GMLAN, refer to Data Link Communications Description and Operation. GMLAN CONNECTOR TERMINAL REPAIR IMPORTANT: A service terminal can be used to replace damaged connector terminals for both high speed and low speed GMLAN systems. When making a connector terminal repair on a GMLAN high speed system with twisted pair wires, do not untwist the wires more than necessary to make the repair. The terminals in the GMLAN system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are available in the J-38125. If the individual terminals are damaged on any GMLAN connection, use the appropriate connector repair procedure in order to repair the terminal. GMLAN WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 5221 Release the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the blue locking tabs on both ends of the connector. Gently slide the TPA up to the released position on both ends. 6. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-13A (GM P/N 12031876-1) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. Page 6291 Page 8981 5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape. Seat Belt Schematic Icons Seat Belt Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons Page 1744 REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. The release tab is located on the top of the wiredress cover. View of connector in released position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Locations Outside Temperature Display Sensor: Locations Displays and Gages Component Views Body Front End 1 - Ambient Air Temperature Sensor Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement (LH6, LS2) Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement (LH6, LS2) Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement (LH6, LS2) Tools Required J39400-A Halogen Leak Detector Removal Procedure 1. Recover the refrigerant. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 2. Remove the washer bottle. 3. Remove the retaining nut (1) from the compressor hose (4) at the accumulator (2). 4. Remove the retaining nut from the compressor hose at the auxiliary HVAC piping connection (3). 5. Remove the compressor hose from the accumulator (2). 6. Remove the compressor hose from the auxiliary HVAC piping. 7. Disconnect the pressure sensor electrical connector. 8. Remove the compressor hose mounting nut from the A/C compressor. 9. Remove the heater hose bracket nut at the engine. Page 425 5. While pushing the terminal forward, insert the J 38125-24 in the release cavity above the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (43-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Page 5864 4. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the rear of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. 5. Once the locking tabs are unlocked, slide the inner connector out of the rear of the connector housing. Page 241 2. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 568 Compressor Clutch Relay: Service and Repair Compressor Relay Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Remove the protective cover from the underhood fuse block. 2. Remove the compressor relay (1) from the underhood fuse block (2). Installation Procedure 1. Install the compressor relay (1) to the underhood fuse block (2). 2. Install the protective hood to the underhood fuse block. Page 5249 Engine Control Module (ECM) C2 (Pin 11 To 54) Page 5284 Fuel Pump Relay: Diagnostic Aids Arrows and Symbols Arrows and Symbols This Service Data uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations. Arrows and Symbols 1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow Basic Knowledge Required GENERAL ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures contained in the service manual. You should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current (amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram, as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. Decimal and Metric Equivalents Decimal and Metric Equivalents Page 6318 IMPORTANT: Ensure that the dress cover and connector body are both in the released position before reassembling. Failure to do so may cause damage to the connector and component. Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (0.64) BOSCH CONNECTORS (0.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While pressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock until the lever is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Pull the rubber boot that covers the wires back to expose the end of the connector dress cover. 4. Place the connector locking lever in the center of the connector. 5. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs that are on the wire end of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover and connector body and pry up. Page 7478 If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200 DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J 39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected. IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J 39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and maximum (MAX) values measured. 1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of a suspected circuit to the other. 2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J 39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep). IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value in order to record the full change. 5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling the connections or the wiring, test driving, or performing other operations. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions. 6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9. Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist. Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections TESTING FOR INTERMITTENT CONDITIONS AND POOR CONNECTIONS TOOLS REQUIRED - J 35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit - J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit When the condition is not currently present, but is indicated in DTC history, the cause may be intermittent. An intermittent may also be the cause when there is a customer complaint, but the symptom cannot be duplicated. Refer to the Symptom Table of the system that is suspect of causing the condition before trying to locate an intermittent condition. Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the following items: Wiring broken inside the insulation - Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector - Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself, and corrosion in the wire to terminal contact area, etc. - Pierced or damaged insulation can allow moisture to enter the wiring causing corrosion. The conductor can corrode inside the insulation, with little visible evidence. Look for swollen and stiff sections of wire in the suspect circuits. - Wiring which has been pinched, cut, or its insulation rubbed through may cause an intermittent open or short as the bare area touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle. - Wiring that comes in contact with hot or exhaust components - Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required, in order to verify the customer concern. - Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. - Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis and Vehicle Data Recorder operation. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any inline connectors before replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation. Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination, usually in the underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit. Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper adapter. Always use the J 35616 when probing connectors. Other causes of terminal deformation are improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT IN BUSSED ELECTRICAL CENTERS (BEC) Page 4075 Engine Oil: Capacity Specifications Engine Oil with Filter ............................................................................................................................ ............................................... 6.0 quarts (5.7 liters) NOTE: All capacities are approximate. When adding, be sure to fill to the approximate level. Recheck fluid level after filling. Page 7623 6. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs located on the opposite side of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover at the connector end and pry up. 7. Remove the dress cover. 8. Cut the tie wrap on the wire bundle. 9. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting a small flat-bladed tool into the small slot in the end of the slider and pushing on the TPA until it comes out of the connector. When the TPA exits the opposite side of the connector, gasp the TPA and pull it completely out of the connector. 10. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 1314 IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals. Front probe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the connector. IMPORTANT: When probing female 0.64 terminals, it is important to use the correct adapter. There have been some revisions to the test adapter for 0.64 terminals. The proper adapter for 0.64 terminals is the J 35616-64B which has a gold terminal and a black wire between the base and tip. Failure to use the proper test adapter may result in damage to the terminal being tested and improper diagnosis. NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Page 8862 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link). - The wire insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. 5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold them between thumb and forefinger. 7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place. - Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction. - Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip. 8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool closes.Ensure that no strands of wire are cut. 10. Crimp the splice on each end (2). Page 7386 5. Once the nose piece retainers are relaxed, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should raise slightly. 6. On the opposite side of the nose piece, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should release completely. If the nose piece does not come off, repeat the procedure on the opposite side. Page 8887 All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system. Locations Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Locations Engine Controls Component Views Upper Right Side of the Engine - Front 1 - Engine 2 - Engine Harness 3 - Air Duct 4 - Mass Air Flow (MAF)/Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor Engine - MIL ON P0116/P1400 Set In Very Cold Temps Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Customer Interest Engine - MIL ON P0116/P1400 Set In Very Cold Temps TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 10-06-04-008A Date: January 24, 2011 Subject: Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) Illuminated at Very Cold Ambient Temperatures When Using Engine Coolant Heater, DTC P0116 and/or P1400 Set (Relocate Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor and Engine Coolant Heater Cord) Models: 2006-2007 Buick Rainier 2009 Buick LaCrosse Super, Allure Super (Canada Only) 2006-2010 Cadillac Escalade 2006-2007 Chevrolet Monte Carlo 2006-2009 Chevrolet Impala SS, TrailBlazer 2006-2010 Chevrolet Avalanche, Express, Silverado Tahoe 2006-2009 GMC Envoy 2006-2010 GMC Savana, Sierra, Yukon 2006-2008 Pontiac Grand Prix 2006-2009 Saab 9-7X Equipped with V8 Engine RPO LC9, LH6, LH8, LH9, L76, LS2, LS4, LFA, LZ1, L92, L94, L9H or L20, L96, LMF, LMG, LY2, LY5, LY6 Please Refer to GMVIS Attention: To properly correct this condition, you must follow both of the procedures to relocate the ECT sensor and the engine coolant heater cord. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add cast iron block engine RPOs and to update the Warranty Information coverage period. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 10-06-04-008 (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). Condition Some customers may comment that the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) illuminates after starting the vehicle when they were using the engine coolant heater in very cold ambient temperatures. This usually occurs in a range of -23 to -40°C (-10 to -40°F) or colder. The technician may observe on a scan tool DTC P0116 and/or P1400 set as Current or in History. Cause This condition may be caused by the engine control module (ECM) determining that the ignition OFF time requirement has been met at start-up and interpreting the temperature difference between the engine coolant temperature (ECT) sensor and the intake air temperature (IAT) sensor as being outside of a calibrated range. Correction Important DO NOT replace the ECM for this condition. Relocating the ECT Sensor 1. Turn ON the ignition with the engine OFF. 2. Perform the diagnostic system check - vehicle. Refer to Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle in SI. ‹› If DTC P0116 and/or P1400 are set and the customer WAS using the engine coolant heater, proceed to Step 3. ‹› If DTC P0116 and/or P1400 are set and the customer WAS NOT using the engine coolant heater, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle in SI. 3. Turn OFF the ignition. Warning To avoid being burned, do not remove the radiator cap or surge tank cap while the engine is hot. The cooling system will release scalding fluid and steam Page 5597 6. Gently pry the plastic terminal retainer down and carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (16-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, pull the two connector halves apart. Page 7906 8. Take a CLEAR digital picture of the Tech 2(R) Vehicle Information screen showing the engine Calibration IDs and Verification Numbers as shown above. Retain the printout information and the Tech 2(R) screen photograph with the repair order. 9. E-mail a copy of the picture to [email protected]. In the subject line of the e-mail include the phrase "V8 Cal" as well as the complete VIN and Dealer BAC. In the body of the e-mail, include the VIN, mileage, R.O. number and BAC. Include a brief description of the customer concern and cause of the concern. Note The dealer will receive an e-mail reply after the calibrations have been validated. The e-mail reply will advise the dealer if the calibrations are OEM. 10. Allow two hours for the PQC to verify the calibrations and set up the case details. ‹› If the PQC determines that the calibrations ARE aftermarket calibrations, DO NOT contact GM Technical Assistance to discuss warranty concerns on the aftermarket calibrations. ALL questions and concerns about warranty should be directed to the dealers Fixed Operations Manager (FOM), (Warranty Manager (WM) in Canada). 11. You may call the PQC two hours after submitting the e-mail for authorization to replace the assembly. This will provide them time to receive, review and set up a case on the request. Please be prepared to provide all the usual documentation that is normally required when requesting an assembly authorization from the PQC. Tech 2(R) Displaying All Zeroes for the Verification Numbers on the Calibration ID and Verification Number Screen If the Tech 2(R) that you are using displays all zeroes for the Verification Numbers as shown, then perform the following steps: 1. Update the Tech 2(R) with the latest software from TIS2WEB. 2. Turn OFF the ignition for 90 seconds. 3. Connect the Tech 2(R) to the vehicle. 4. Turn ON the ignition, and build the vehicle. Observe the Tech 2(R) Calibration ID and Verification Number screen for proper operation. ‹› If the Tech 2(R) screen still does not display properly, then turn OFF the ignition for 90 seconds again. Turn ON the ignition and observe the same screen for proper operation. Retrieving Calibrations From a Global A Vehicle This information applies to the 2010 Camaro and is typical of the procedure that will be used on Global A vehicles. 1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Connect the MDI to the Data Link Connector (DLC) of the vehicle. Note Use the USB port to make the following MDI connection: Page 8811 7. Apply pressure and gently rock the cover until one locking leg is unseated. 8. Continue to apply pressure and rock the cover until the second locking leg is unseated. Repeat procedure for the other side of the dress cover and remove the cover. 9. Use J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) to gently lift the terminal retaining tab while gently pulling the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 10. If the terminal is severely bent or damaged, it may be possible on some connectors to push the wire out of the front of the connector instead of Page 497 4. Once the front 2 locks are unlocked, lift the front of the dress cover and pull it forward. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the small slot on the TPA and pushing down until the TPA releases. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to angle or rock the J 38125-21 tool when inserting it into the connector or the tool may break. Insert the J 38125-21 (GM P/N 15381651-2) tool into the round canal between the terminals cavities at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to repair Micro 64 connector terminals. The Micro 64 connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-64 (M jaw) was developed to crimp Micro 64 terminals. The J 38125-64 crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. The J 38125-64 crimping tool is also designed to crimp both the wire and the insulation at the same time. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro 64 terminals. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. 1. Cut the wire as close to the damaged terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. Page 8189 3. Ensure that the terminal release tang access panel is in the correct location to access the terminals. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) into the terminal release tang access slot located behind the access panel of the connector and press down on the terminal while carefully pulling the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Tyco/AMP Connectors (0.25 Cap) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (025 CAP) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component by pressing down on the connector position assurance (CPA). Page 2041 breakers are used. CIRCUIT BREAKER This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high current is removed. POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) CIRCUIT BREAKER This type greatly increases its resistance when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker will re-close within a second or 2. Circuit Protection - Fuses CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSES The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and examine the element in the fuse for an open (2). If not broken (1), also check for continuity using a DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one of equal current rating. Circuit Protection - Fusible Links CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSIBLE LINKS Page 2627 5. While pushing the terminal forward, insert the J 38125-24 in the release cavity above the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (43-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Page 3375 - In some cases Delphi will actually be printed on the connector. If Delphi is not printed on the connector, look for PED. In both cases there is no specific orientation for Delphi or PED and they can appear anywhere on the connector. - FCI connectors may have the FCI logo on their connectors. The logo is the letters FCI with an "A" above it. - JAE connector have JAE in small letters on their connectors. Page 6723 6. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by pressing on the tang. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (SENSOR) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) tool into the cavity on the lower right hand face of the connector until the terminal release tang access panel slides over. Locations Crankshaft Position Sensor: Locations Engine Controls Component Views Lower Right Side of the Engine - Rear 1 - Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor 2 - Knock Sensor (KS) 2 - Right 3 - Engine Harness 4 Starter 5 - Engine Page 7874 8. Disconnect the 32-way tan electrical connector (2) from the BCM. 9. Disconnect the 24-way gray electrical connector (1) from the BCM. 10. With an upward motion, disconnect the body wiring extension (1) from the rear electrical center. 11. Remove the body wiring extension from the vehicle. INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 1. IMPORTANT: Ensure the sliding latch is fully extended before connecting the body wiring extension to the rear electrical center. Using a downward motion, install the body wiring extension (1) to the rear electrical center. 2. Connect the 24-way gray electrical connector (1) to the BCM. 3. Connect the 32-way tan electrical connector (2) to the BCM. 4. Connect the body wiring extension (1) to the BCM. Page 2666 Impact Sensor: Diagrams SIR Connector End Views Inflatable Restraint Side Impact Sensor (SIS) - Left (ASF) Inflatable Restraint Side Impact Sensor (SIS) - Right (ASF) Rollover Sensor Page 6595 View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. View of the release tool being used for the smaller terminals. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (2-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON Air Filter Element: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-013B Date: February 01, 2007 INFORMATION Subject: Automatic Transmission Shift, Engine Driveability Concerns or Service Engine Soon (SES) Light On as a Result of the Use of an Excessively/Over-Oiled Aftermarket, Reusable Air Filter Models: 2007 and Prior GM Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2007 and Prior Saturn Models 2003-2007 HUMMER H2 2006-2007 HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 04-07-30-013A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle). The use of an excessively/over-oiled aftermarket, reusable air filter may result in: Service Engine Soon (SES) light on Transmission shift concerns, slipping and damaged clutch(es) or band(s) Engine driveability concerns, poor acceleration from a stop, limited engine RPM range The oil that is used on these air filter elements may be transferred onto the Mass Air Flow (MAF) sensor causing contamination of the sensor. As a result, the Grams per Second (GPS) signal from the MAF may be low and any or all of the concerns listed above may occur. When servicing a vehicle with any of these concerns, be sure to check for the presence of an aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter. The MAF, GPS reading should be compared to a like vehicle with an OEM air box and filter under the same driving conditions to verify the concern. The use of an aftermarket reusable air filter DOES NOT void the vehicle's warranty. If an aftermarket reusable air filter is used, technicians should inspect the MAF sensor element and the air induction hose for contamination of oil prior to making warranty repairs. Transmission or engine driveability concerns (related to the MAF sensor being contaminated with oil) that are the result of the use of an aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter are not considered to be warrantable repair items. Page 4585 Checking Aftermarket Accessories CHECKING AFTERMARKET ACCESSORIES Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits: - CAUTION: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol. - NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice. OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol. Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the cause of the problems. Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include: Power feeds connected to points other than the battery - Antenna location - Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring - Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line - Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories. Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions INDUCING INTERMITTENT FAULT CONDITIONS TOOLS REQUIRED J 25070 Heat Gun Many intermittent open or shorted circuits are affected by harness/connector movement that is caused by vibration, engine torque, bumps/rough pavement, etc. In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness if the malfunction appears to be Page 1756 8. Insert the J 38125-213 into the small terminal release hole on the nose piece and gently pull on the back of the wire. 9. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Repairing Connector Terminals REPAIRING CONNECTOR TERMINALS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following: Push to Seat terminals - Pull to Seat terminals Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your terminal repair. The J-38125 contains further information. 1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.For cable seal terminals, remove the seal. 2. Apply the correct cable seal per gage size of the wire, if used.Slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation removal. 3. Remove the insulation. 4. For sealed terminals only, align the seal with the end of the cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal.For sealed terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal. 6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.For sealed terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable. 8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals excepting Micro-Pack 100.64 size. Soldering Micro-Pack 100 World terminals may damage the terminal. Sumitomo Connectors SUMITOMO CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 336 Electronic Brake Control Module: Diagrams Antilock Brake System Connector End Views Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM) Page 818 MEASURING FREQUENCY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal. IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM to autorange to an appropriate range. 1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency measured. Measuring Voltage MEASURING VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit. 1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods: - Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. - Turn ON the engine. - Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls. - Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested. 3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The DMM displays the voltage measured at that point. Measuring Voltage Drop MEASURING VOLTAGE DROP NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points. Probing Electrical Connectors PROBING ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS Engine - MIL ON P0116/P1400 Set In Very Cold Temps Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - MIL ON P0116/P1400 Set In Very Cold Temps TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 10-06-04-008A Date: January 24, 2011 Subject: Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) Illuminated at Very Cold Ambient Temperatures When Using Engine Coolant Heater, DTC P0116 and/or P1400 Set (Relocate Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor and Engine Coolant Heater Cord) Models: 2006-2007 Buick Rainier 2009 Buick LaCrosse Super, Allure Super (Canada Only) 2006-2010 Cadillac Escalade 2006-2007 Chevrolet Monte Carlo 2006-2009 Chevrolet Impala SS, TrailBlazer 2006-2010 Chevrolet Avalanche, Express, Silverado Tahoe 2006-2009 GMC Envoy 2006-2010 GMC Savana, Sierra, Yukon 2006-2008 Pontiac Grand Prix 2006-2009 Saab 9-7X Equipped with V8 Engine RPO LC9, LH6, LH8, LH9, L76, LS2, LS4, LFA, LZ1, L92, L94, L9H or L20, L96, LMF, LMG, LY2, LY5, LY6 Please Refer to GMVIS Attention: To properly correct this condition, you must follow both of the procedures to relocate the ECT sensor and the engine coolant heater cord. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add cast iron block engine RPOs and to update the Warranty Information coverage period. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 10-06-04-008 (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). Condition Some customers may comment that the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) illuminates after starting the vehicle when they were using the engine coolant heater in very cold ambient temperatures. This usually occurs in a range of -23 to -40°C (-10 to -40°F) or colder. The technician may observe on a scan tool DTC P0116 and/or P1400 set as Current or in History. Cause This condition may be caused by the engine control module (ECM) determining that the ignition OFF time requirement has been met at start-up and interpreting the temperature difference between the engine coolant temperature (ECT) sensor and the intake air temperature (IAT) sensor as being outside of a calibrated range. Correction Important DO NOT replace the ECM for this condition. Relocating the ECT Sensor 1. Turn ON the ignition with the engine OFF. 2. Perform the diagnostic system check - vehicle. Refer to Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle in SI. ‹› If DTC P0116 and/or P1400 are set and the customer WAS using the engine coolant heater, proceed to Step 3. ‹› If DTC P0116 and/or P1400 are set and the customer WAS NOT using the engine coolant heater, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle in SI. 3. Turn OFF the ignition. Warning To avoid being burned, do not remove the radiator cap or surge tank cap while the engine is hot. The cooling system will release scalding fluid and steam Page 147 - HVAC Actuator - Inflatable Restraint Sensing and Diagnostic Module (SDM) - Any AIR BAG module - Seatbelt Lap Anchor Pretensioner - Seatbelt Retractor Pretensioner - An SIR system connection or connector condition resulting in the following DTCs being set: B0015, B0016, B0019, B0020, B0022, or B0023 - Powertrain Control Module (PCM) - Remote Control Door Lock Receiver (RCDLR) - Transmission Control Module (TCM) Correction Important DO NOT replace the control module, wiring or component for the following conditions: - The condition is intermittent and cannot be duplicated. - The condition is present and by disconnecting and reconnecting the connector the condition can no longer be duplicated. Use the following procedure to correct the conditions listed above. 1. Install a scan tool and perform the Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle. Retrieve and record any existing history or current DTCs from all of the control modules (refer to SI). ‹› If any DTC(s) are set, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle to identify the connector(s) of the control module/component which may be causing the condition (refer to SI). ‹› If DTCs are not set, refer to Symptoms - Vehicle to identify the connector(s) of the control module/component which may be causing the condition (refer to SI). 2. When identified, use the appropriate DTC Diagnostics, Symptoms, Schematics, Component Connector End Views and Component Locator documents to locate and disconnect the affected harness connector(s) which are causing the condition. Note Fretting corrosion looks like little dark smudges on electrical terminals and appear where the actual electrical contact is being made. In less severe cases it may be unable to be seen or identified without the use of a magnifying glass. Important DO NOT apply an excessive amount of dielectric lubricant to the connectors as shown, as hydrolock may result when attempting to mate the connectors. Use ONLY a clean nylon brush that is dedicated to the repair of the conditions in this bulletin. 3. With a one-inch nylon bristle brush, apply dielectric lubricant to both the module/component side and the harness side of the affected connector(s). 4. Reconnect the affected connector(s) and wipe away any excess lubricant that may be present. 5. Attempt to duplicate the condition by using the following information: - DTC Diagnostic Procedure - Circuit/System Description - Conditions for Running the DTC - Conditions for Setting the DTC - Diagnostic Aids - Circuit/System Verification ‹› If the condition cannot be duplicated, the repair is complete. ‹› If the condition can be duplicated, then follow the appropriate DTC, Symptom or Circuit/System Testing procedure (refer to SI). Repair Order Documentation Page 5046 1. Install the exhaust hanger to the catalytic converter. 2. Install the catalytic converter and exhaust hanger assembly to the vehicle. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 3. Install the bolt securing the catalytic converter pipe hanger to the transmission mount. Tighten the bolt to 30 N.m (22 lb ft). 4. Install the transmission mount. 5. Install the catalytic converter pipe to the exhaust manifold with a NEW exhaust seal. 6. Hand thread the nuts evenly against the exhaust flange until the pipe is secure. Tighten the nuts to 50 N.m (37 lb ft). 7. Connect the H2OS electrical connector. 8. Lower the vehicle. Page 359 IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals. Front probe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the connector. IMPORTANT: When probing female 0.64 terminals, it is important to use the correct adapter. There have been some revisions to the test adapter for 0.64 terminals. The proper adapter for 0.64 terminals is the J 35616-64B which has a gold terminal and a black wire between the base and tip. Failure to use the proper test adapter may result in damage to the terminal being tested and improper diagnosis. NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Page 5990 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the rear TPA from the connector. 7. IMPORTANT: The front TPA cannot be removed from the connector. Only move it to the release point. Use a small flat-blade tool to move the front TPA to the release position. 8. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 9. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Molex Connectors Page 6354 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. 4. Remove the dress cover by using a flat bladed tool to release the dress cover locking tabs and lift up on the dress cover. 5. Cut the tie wrap that holds the wires to the connector body. Page 5320 The first connector design of the Micro-Pack 100W (1) has a white connector interface that holds the terminals. The second design of the Micro-Pack 100W (2) has a gray interface to hold the terminals. Also, the first design has terminal cavities that are further apart (3 mm centerline) and offset from the other row of terminal cavities in the connector. The second design has terminals cavities that are closer together (2.54 mm centerline) and aligned vertically. One other way to identify the second design is the thin strip of material that runs along the outside of the cavities. IMPORTANT: There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W terminals which are very similar. Ensure that you have the correct terminal before crimping the new terminal to the wire. The first design connector uses the longer terminal (1) that has a raised area in front of the recess in the terminal. The second design connector uses the shorter terminal without the raised area. Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro-Pack 100W connectors. Some Micro-Pack 100W connector disassembly procedures will vary. Use this procedure as a guide. 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 8959 2. Use a small flat-bladed tool to release the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting the tool in the small recess on the side of the connector and pushing up until the TPA releases from the connector body. The TPA should raise just slightly. Do not try to remove the TPA. IMPORTANT: The TPA on this connector cannot be removed unless the terminals are removed first. The TPA will come out of the connector body, but only slightly. When the TPA is slightly raised the terminals can be removed. Using excessive force to remove the TPA with the terminals still in the connector will damage the connector. 3. Repeat the process for the other side of the connector. 4. Ensure that the TPA is in the proper position to remove the terminals. Page 7565 Page 1381 Release the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the blue locking tabs on both ends of the connector. Gently slide the TPA up to the released position on both ends. 6. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-13A (GM P/N 12031876-1) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. Page 5207 8. Insert the J 38125-213 into the small terminal release hole on the nose piece and gently pull on the back of the wire. 9. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Repairing Connector Terminals REPAIRING CONNECTOR TERMINALS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following: Push to Seat terminals - Pull to Seat terminals Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your terminal repair. The J-38125 contains further information. 1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.For cable seal terminals, remove the seal. 2. Apply the correct cable seal per gage size of the wire, if used.Slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation removal. 3. Remove the insulation. 4. For sealed terminals only, align the seal with the end of the cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal.For sealed terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal. 6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.For sealed terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable. 8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals excepting Micro-Pack 100.64 size. Soldering Micro-Pack 100 World terminals may damage the terminal. Sumitomo Connectors SUMITOMO CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 4140 9. Install the battery cable channel to the oil pan. 10. Install the battery cable channel bolt to the oil pan. Tighten the bolt to 12 N.m (106 lb in). 11. Install the flywheel inspection cover to the left side of the transmission. 12. Install the starter. Refer to Starter Motor Replacement (4.2L Engine) Starter Motor Replacement (5.3L and 6.0L Engines). 13. Install the inner axle shaft. Refer to Front Drive Axle Inner Shaft Replacement. 14. Install the transmission oil cooler line retaining bracket and bolt. Tighten the bolt to 9 N.m (80 lb in). Page 8389 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (BSK) BOSCH CONNECTORS (BSK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 3. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 4. Insert the J 38125-561 tool into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 5. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is Page 7691 11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the solder equipment. 12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. 13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to cover the first piece of tape. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE SLEEVES TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit IMPORTANT: Use only dura seal splice sleeves. Other splice sleeves may not protect the splice from moisture or provide a good electrical connection. Use duraseal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. Use duraseal splice sleeves where there is special requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire using duraseal splice sleeves. Page 2040 View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. 4. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers CIRCUIT PROTECTION - CIRCUIT BREAKERS A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types of circuit Page 1646 11. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 12. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 13. Center the high temperature SCT1 shrink tube over the DuraSeal splice sleeve. 14. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the high temperature heat shrink tubing. 15. Gradually move the heat from the center to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 16. Replace any reflective tape and clips that may have been remove during the repair. Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation REPAIRING DAMAGED WIRE INSULATION Wire Size Conversion Page 6369 5. While pushing the terminal forward, insert the J 38125-24 in the release cavity above the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (43-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Page 832 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. 4. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front of the connector. Page 8655 to analyze the data during the time a vehicle condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a trigger point that you have determined. Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2 snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a first-in, first-out basis. If a third snapshot is taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost. Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types: Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice - Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200 frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not lost if the Scan Tool is powered down. The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis. The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected values by plotting 3 parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful, especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC. Testing for a Short to Voltage TESTING FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4. Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt, there is a short to voltage in the circuit. Testing for Continuity TESTING FOR CONTINUITY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6. Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit. 7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity. With a Test Lamp IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits. 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6. If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity. Testing for Electrical Intermittents TESTING FOR ELECTRICAL INTERMITTENTS Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment. - Testing for Short to Ground - Testing for Continuity - Testing for a Short to Voltage Locations Power Seat Control Module: Locations Beneath Driver Seat Cushion Page 6254 3. Ensure that the terminal release tang access panel is in the correct location to access the terminals. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) into the terminal release tang access slot located behind the access panel of the connector and press down on the terminal while carefully pulling the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Tyco/AMP Connectors (0.25 Cap) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (025 CAP) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component by pressing down on the connector position assurance (CPA). Page 2634 breakers are used. CIRCUIT BREAKER This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high current is removed. POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) CIRCUIT BREAKER This type greatly increases its resistance when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker will re-close within a second or 2. Circuit Protection - Fuses CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSES The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and examine the element in the fuse for an open (2). If not broken (1), also check for continuity using a DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one of equal current rating. Circuit Protection - Fusible Links CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSIBLE LINKS Page 1713 Release the tabs that are holding the wiredress cover to the connector body. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the slots on both ends of the connector body. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. J 38125-216 can also be used to remove the nose piece. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by lifting the terminal retaining tabs on the inside of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 3934 5. Remove the crankshaft balancer bolt. Do not discard the crankshaft balancer bolt. The balancer bolt will be used during the balancer installation procedure. 6. Use J 41816 and J 41816-2 in order to remove the crankshaft balancer. 7. Remove J 41816 and J 41816-2 from the crankshaft balancer. 8. Clean and inspect the crankshaft balancer. Refer to Crankshaft Balancer Cleaning and Inspection. Installation Procedure Page 8883 Locations Knock Sensor: Locations Engine Controls Component Views Lower Left Side of Engine - Rear 1 - G108 2 - Knock Sensor (KS) 1 - Left 3 - Engine 4 - G107 5 - Engine Harness Lower Right Side of the Engine - Rear Engine - Low Oil Lamp ON/Oil Leaks Oil Pressure Sensor: Customer Interest Engine - Low Oil Lamp ON/Oil Leaks TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 07-06-01-004A Date: November 25, 2008 Subject: All Vortec(R) GEN IV V8 Engines - LY2 LS4 LC9 LH6 LMG LY5 LS2 L76 LY6 L92 LS7, Low Oil Level Indicator Lamp On and/or Engine Oil Leak (Reseal Oil Pressure Sensor) Models Supercede: This bulletin is being updated to include a labor operation number for CTS-V and Corvette models. Please discard Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 07-06-01-004 (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System). Condition Some customers may comment on a low oil level indicator lamp on and/or engine oil leak. Upon further investigation, the technician may find that the oil leak is at the oil pressure sensor that is threaded into the valve lifter oil manifold (VLOM) assembly and/or engine valley cover. Correction If the engine oil leak was found to be at the engine oil pressure sensor, then remove the oil pressure sensor and reseal with a pipe sealant with Teflon or equivalent, P/N 12346004 (in Canada, P/N 10953480). Refer to Engine Oil Pressure Sensor and/or Switch Replacement in SI. Parts Information Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models) Page 8669 6. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs located on the opposite side of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover at the connector end and pry up. 7. Remove the dress cover. 8. Cut the tie wrap on the wire bundle. 9. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting a small flat-bladed tool into the small slot in the end of the slider and pushing on the TPA until it comes out of the connector. When the TPA exits the opposite side of the connector, gasp the TPA and pull it completely out of the connector. 10. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 4396 Depress the locks that are located on both sides of the wiredress cover and pull the lever over and past the locks. View of the connector when released from the component. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the front of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool push down on one of the locking tabs and pull the cover up until the dress cover releases. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. Page 9003 Valve Deactivation Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids Arrows and Symbols Arrows and Symbols This Service Data uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations. Arrows and Symbols 1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow Basic Knowledge Required GENERAL ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures contained in the service manual. You should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current (amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram, as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. Decimal and Metric Equivalents Decimal and Metric Equivalents Page 5504 Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Connector Views Engine Controls Connector End Views Mass Air Flow (MAF)/Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor Page 2505 The engine harness may be repaired using the J-38125. High Temperature Wiring Repairs HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperatures, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time may use materials i.e. wires, connectors, and shielding that has a higher heat rating than typical wiring. When making a repair in a high temperature area observe the following: Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature to replace any damaged wire. - Replace any heat shielding that is removed. - Cover any DuraSeal splice sleeves with SCT1 shrink tubing (available in the J-38125 Terminal Repair kit). - After making a wiring repair, ensure that the location of the wiring is not moved closer to the heat source. IDENTIFYING HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperature, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time need special considerations when making wiring repairs. Areas that may be exposed to higher temperatures can be identified by heat resistant materials that are being used in those areas. These materials may include heat reflective tape, moon tape, and high temperature shrink tubing. Also conduit and other protective coverings may be used. Because conduit or similar coverings are used throughout the vehicle regardless of the temperature, it may be necessary for the technician to determine if an area is exposed to excessive heat before making a wiring repair. Obvious areas of consideration would be any area located near the exhaust manifolds, catalytic converter, and exhaust pipes. The J-38125 contains much of the material you will need to perform repairs on areas exposed to high heat. The kit contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves to crimp and seal connections - High temperature SCT1 shrink tubing to protect the splice sleeves - A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct crimp tool to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools to remove the terminals from the connectors The J-38125 does not contain wire that is suitable to high temperature exposure. Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature of the same or larger gage size as the original wire when repair damage wire. Also replace any reflective tape that you remove during the repair. HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature rating of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125 and then encapsulate the splice sleeve using the high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the order listed. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip keeping all of the wire strands intact. Page 7628 - In some cases Delphi will actually be printed on the connector. If Delphi is not printed on the connector, look for PED. In both cases there is no specific orientation for Delphi or PED and they can appear anywhere on the connector. - FCI connectors may have the FCI logo on their connectors. The logo is the letters FCI with an "A" above it. - JAE connector have JAE in small letters on their connectors. Page 7164 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (BSK) BOSCH CONNECTORS (BSK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 3. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 4. Insert the J 38125-561 tool into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 5. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is Page 1789 6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias. Reference the appropriate service manual wiring schematic to obtain the correct diode installation position. 7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for the soldering equipment. 8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed. 9. IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode attachment points with tape. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape. Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable SPLICING TWISTED OR SHIELDED CABLE Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable. 1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splice is made. 3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire. Staggering the splices by 65 mm (2.5 in) is recommended. 4. IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical contact with the drain wire. Re-assemble the cable. Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape. - Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1). - Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire. - Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape. Page 5590 6. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by pressing on the tang. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (SENSOR) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) tool into the cavity on the lower right hand face of the connector until the terminal release tang access panel slides over. Page 6530 If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200 DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J 39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected. IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J 39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and maximum (MAX) values measured. 1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of a suspected circuit to the other. 2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J 39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep). IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value in order to record the full change. 5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling the connections or the wiring, test driving, or performing other operations. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions. 6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9. Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist. Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections TESTING FOR INTERMITTENT CONDITIONS AND POOR CONNECTIONS TOOLS REQUIRED - J 35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit - J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit When the condition is not currently present, but is indicated in DTC history, the cause may be intermittent. An intermittent may also be the cause when there is a customer complaint, but the symptom cannot be duplicated. Refer to the Symptom Table of the system that is suspect of causing the condition before trying to locate an intermittent condition. Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the following items: Wiring broken inside the insulation - Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector - Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself, and corrosion in the wire to terminal contact area, etc. - Pierced or damaged insulation can allow moisture to enter the wiring causing corrosion. The conductor can corrode inside the insulation, with little visible evidence. Look for swollen and stiff sections of wire in the suspect circuits. - Wiring which has been pinched, cut, or its insulation rubbed through may cause an intermittent open or short as the bare area touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle. - Wiring that comes in contact with hot or exhaust components - Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required, in order to verify the customer concern. - Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. - Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis and Vehicle Data Recorder operation. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any inline connectors before replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation. Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination, usually in the underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit. Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper adapter. Always use the J 35616 when probing connectors. Other causes of terminal deformation are improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT IN BUSSED ELECTRICAL CENTERS (BEC) Page 6547 - Kostel - Molex - Sumitomo - Tyco/AMP - Yazaki Identifying the manufacturer of a connector is often difficult. When trying to determine the manufacturer of a connector, look for specific identifying marks that are unique to that connector supplier. Most of these identify marks are hard to find or see. Check the connector carefully and refer to the information below for pictures and descriptions of connector identification markings. - Most of AFLs connectors have EPC on their connector body. Some of the smaller connectors will not have any markings on them. - In some cases Bosch will actually be printed on the connector. If Bosch does not appear on the connector, look for the Bosch logo. The Bosch logo is a circle with a blunted arrow inside. This logo can appear anywhere on the connector and is often very small. Page 1864 - JST connectors have JST in small letters on their connectors, similar to that above. The location of the logo will vary with the connector size and style. - Kostel has an "LK" with a circle around it. These connector are usually used as a transmissions connection and are currently use on some Cadillac vehicles. Page 7856 Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Heated Oxygen Sensor Replacement - Bank 1 Sensor 2 Heated Oxygen Sensor Replacement - Bank 1 Sensor 2 Removal Procedure 1. Raise and suitably support the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. Notice: Refer to Heated Oxygen and Oxygen Sensor Notice. 2. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) retainer. 3. Disconnect the heated oxygen sensor (HO2S) electrical connector. Notice: Refer to Excessive Force and Oxygen Sensor Notice. 4. Remove the HO2S (2). Installation Procedure Important: A special anti-seize compound is used on the HO2S threads. The compound consists of liquid graphite and glass beads. The graphite tends to burn away, but the glass beads remain, making the sensor easier to remove. New, or service replacement sensors already have the compound applied to the threads. If the sensor is removed from an exhaust component and if for any reason the sensor is to be reinstalled, the threads must have anti-seize compound applied before the reinstallation. Page 461 Utility/Van Zoning UTILITY/VAN ZONING Page 8523 View of connector in released position. 4. Disconnect the connector from the component. 5. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Release the rear lower half of the wiredress cover. Page 2449 - In some cases Delphi will actually be printed on the connector. If Delphi is not printed on the connector, look for PED. In both cases there is no specific orientation for Delphi or PED and they can appear anywhere on the connector. - FCI connectors may have the FCI logo on their connectors. The logo is the letters FCI with an "A" above it. - JAE connector have JAE in small letters on their connectors. Page 7614 Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. For connectors with a bolt in the dress cover, turn the bolt counterclockwise to remove the connector from the component. 2. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. Page 9045 The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors. 1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position. 4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool J 38125-10A (GM P/N 12014012-1) into the front (mating end) of the connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal through the back of the connector (2). IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector. 6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. 7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily. 10. Perform system check. Delphi Connectors (12 Way) DELPHI CONNECTORS (12-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. Wheels - Chrome Wheel Staining/Pitting/Corrosion Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels - Chrome Wheel Staining/Pitting/Corrosion INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 00-03-10-002F Date: April 21, 2011 Subject: Chemical Staining, Pitting, Corrosion and/or Spotted Appearance of Chromed Aluminum Wheels Models: 2012 and Prior GM Cars and Trucks Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update model years, suggest additional restorative products and add additional corrosion information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 00-03-10-002E (Section 03 - Suspension). Important You may give a copy of this bulletin to the customer. What is Chemical Staining of Chrome Wheels? Figure 1 Chemical staining in most cases results from acid based cleaners (refer to Figure 1 for an example). These stains are frequently milky, black, or greenish in appearance. They result from using cleaning solutions that contain acids on chrome wheels. Soap and water is usually sufficient to clean wheels. If the customer insists on using a wheel cleaner they should only use one that specifically states that it is safe for chromed wheels and does not contain anything in the following list. (Dealers should also survey any products they use during prep or normal cleaning of stock units for these chemicals.) - Ammonium Bifluoride (fluoride source for dissolution of chrome) - Hydrofluoric Acid (directly dissolves chrome) - Hydrochloric Acid (directly dissolves chrome) - Sodium Dodecylbenzenesulfonic Acid - Sulfamic Acid - Phosphoric Acid - Hydroxyacetic Acid Notice Many wheel cleaner instructions advise to take care to avoid contact with painted surfaces. Most customers think of painted surfaces as the fenders, quarter panels and other exterior sheet metal. Many vehicles have painted brake calipers. Acidic wheel cleaners may craze, crack, or discolor the paint on the brake calipers. Damage from wheel cleaners is not covered under the vehicle new car warranty. Soap and water applied with a soft brush is usually all that is required to clean the calipers. Whenever any wheel cleaner is used, it must be THOROUGHLY rinsed off of the wheel with clean, clear water. Special care must be taken to rinse under the hub cap, balance weights, wheel nuts, lug nut caps, between the wheel cladding and off the back side of the wheel. Wheels returned to the Warranty Parts Center (WPC) that exhibit damage from wheel cleaners most often have the damage around and under the wheel weight where the cleaner was incompletely flushed away. Notice Page 3831 5. Remove the camshaft sprocket bolts. Notice: Do not turn the crankshaft assembly after the timing chain has been removed in order to prevent damage to the piston assemblies or the valves. 6. Remove the camshaft sprocket and reposition the timing chain. 7. Remove the camshaft retainer bolts and retainer. Notice: All camshaft journals are the same diameter, so care must be used in removing or installing the camshaft to avoid damage to the camshaft bearings. 8. Remove the camshaft. 1. Install three 8-1.25 x 100 mm (M8-1.25 x 4.0 in) bolts to the bolt holes in the front of the camshaft. 2. Using the bolts as a handle, carefully rotate and pull the camshaft out of the engine block. Page 4919 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert terminal into the appropriate terminal holder until it hits bottom and stops. The correct terminal holder is determined by the wire size. Also ensure that the terminals wings are pointing towards the former on the tool and the release locator. 5. Insert the stripped cable into the terminal. Insulation should be visible on both sides of the terminal insulation wings. 6. Compress the handles until the ratchet automatically releases. 7. Place the terminal into the appropriate cavity and assemble the connector. Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO-PACK 100W) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W connectors. These connectors are very similar but use different terminals and have some minor physical differences also. Page 5243 Page 4477 MEASURING FREQUENCY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal. IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM to autorange to an appropriate range. 1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency measured. Measuring Voltage MEASURING VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit. 1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods: - Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. - Turn ON the engine. - Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls. - Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested. 3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The DMM displays the voltage measured at that point. Measuring Voltage Drop MEASURING VOLTAGE DROP NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points. Probing Electrical Connectors PROBING ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS Page 6025 11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the solder equipment. 12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. 13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to cover the first piece of tape. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE SLEEVES TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit IMPORTANT: Use only dura seal splice sleeves. Other splice sleeves may not protect the splice from moisture or provide a good electrical connection. Use duraseal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. Use duraseal splice sleeves where there is special requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire using duraseal splice sleeves. Page 7101 5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape. Seat Belt Schematic Icons Seat Belt Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons Page 6191 Refer to the following table as a guide in selecting the correct test adapter for front probing connectors: Backprobe IMPORTANT: Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures. - Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector. - Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large of a test probe. - After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected, test for proper terminal contact. Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the connector. Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure SCAN TOOL SNAPSHOT PROCEDURE Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used Page 335 Electronic Brake Control Module: Locations Antilock Brake System Component Views Electronic Brake Control Module 1 - Frame 2 - Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM) Page 6646 Page 1702 MEASURING FREQUENCY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal. IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM to autorange to an appropriate range. 1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency measured. Measuring Voltage MEASURING VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit. 1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods: - Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. - Turn ON the engine. - Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls. - Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested. 3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The DMM displays the voltage measured at that point. Measuring Voltage Drop MEASURING VOLTAGE DROP NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points. Probing Electrical Connectors PROBING ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS TPMS System - Service And Re-Learning Sensor IDs Tire Pressure Module: Technical Service Bulletins TPMS System - Service And Re-Learning Sensor IDs INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 10-03-16-001 Date: July 19, 2010 Subject: TPMS System Service and Re-Learning Sensor IDs Models: 2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2 2009 and Prior HUMMER H3 2010 and Prior Saturn Models 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X with Wheel-Mounted Tire Pressure Sensors In the event that the spare tire, which is normally not equipped with a tire pressure monitor (TPM) sensor, is installed in place of one of the road tires and the vehicle is driven above 40 km/h (25 mph) for 20 minutes or more, the TPM indicator icon on the instrument panel cluster (IPC) will flash for approximately one minute and then remain on steady each time the ignition is turned ON, indicating a diagnostic trouble code (DTC) has been set. The driver information center (DIC), if equipped, will also display a SERVICE TIRE MONITOR type message. When the road tire is repaired and reinstalled in the original location, the TPM indicator icon illumination and DIC message may remain displayed until the DTC is cleared. To ensure that the TPM indicator and the DIC message are cleared after service, it is necessary to clear any TPM DTCs using a scan tool. If a scan tool is unavailable, performing the TPM relearn procedure using a TPM diagnostic tool will provide the same results. It is advised to perform the relearn procedure away from other vehicles to prevent picking up a stray sensor signal. If one or more of the TPM sensors are missing or damaged and have been replaced, then the relearn procedure must be performed. Disclaimer Page 8538 - Yazaki has a wedge or arrow shape, similar to that shown. Delphi Connectors (Micro .64) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro 64 connectors. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. The lever lock may be located on the top or sides of the wire dress cover. Page 2174 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link). - The wire insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. 5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold them between thumb and forefinger. 7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place. - Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction. - Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip. 8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool closes.Ensure that no strands of wire are cut. 10. Crimp the splice on each end (2). Page 3418 3. Ensure that the terminal release tang access panel is in the correct location to access the terminals. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) into the terminal release tang access slot located behind the access panel of the connector and press down on the terminal while carefully pulling the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Tyco/AMP Connectors (0.25 Cap) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (025 CAP) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component by pressing down on the connector position assurance (CPA). Page 3641 longer. Important Whenever a wheel is refinished, the mounting surface and the wheel nut contact surfaces must not be painted or clearcoated. Coating these surfaces could affect the wheel nut torque. When re-mounting a tire on an aluminum wheel, coated balance weights must be used in order to reduce the chance of future cosmetic damage. Disclaimer Page 6638 For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 6076 View of connector in released position. 4. Disconnect the connector from the component. 5. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Release the rear lower half of the wiredress cover. Page 5867 2. Use a small flat-bladed tool to release the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting the tool in the small recess on the side of the connector and pushing up until the TPA releases from the connector body. The TPA should raise just slightly. Do not try to remove the TPA. IMPORTANT: The TPA on this connector cannot be removed unless the terminals are removed first. The TPA will come out of the connector body, but only slightly. When the TPA is slightly raised the terminals can be removed. Using excessive force to remove the TPA with the terminals still in the connector will damage the connector. 3. Repeat the process for the other side of the connector. 4. Ensure that the TPA is in the proper position to remove the terminals. Page 4657 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert a small flat-blade tool in the slot below the front loaded terminal position assurance (TPA) and pry up. 3. Remove the TPA by pulling it out of the connector. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-553 (GM P/N 15315247) on a slight upward angle into the cavity below the terminal to be removed. Ensure that the pointed on the end of the tool is facing the bottom of the terminal and it stays in contact with the terminal until it stops on the plastic terminal retainer. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 3037 Disclaimer Page 3399 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully raise the TPA on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA cannot be removed from the connector while there are terminals present in the connector body. View of the TPA when removed from the connector body. 4. Use the J 38125-12A tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the left side of the terminal release cavity as shown in the graphic. Use the tool to move the terminal release to the right with a gentle prying motion. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 2438 Release the tabs that are holding the wiredress cover to the connector body. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the slots on both ends of the connector body. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. J 38125-216 can also be used to remove the nose piece. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by lifting the terminal retaining tabs on the inside of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 7515 Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. FCI Connectors FCI CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 3256 Connector Anatomy Connector Repairs contains a list of all connector repairs. The connector repairs are listed by the connector manufacturer and then by connector type. If the technician cannot identify the manufacturer of the connector, refer to Identifying Connectors below. Knowing the connector manufacturer will assist in finding the correct connector repair from the following list: - Connector Position Assurance Locks - Terminal Position Assurance Locks - Bosch Connectors (0.64) Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) Bosch Connectors (BSK) Bosch Connectors (ECM) - Delphi Connectors (Micro.64) Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) Delphi Connectors (12-Way) - Tyco/AMP Connectors (CM 42-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) Tyco/AMP Connectors (025 Cap) Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) - Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) - Repairing Connector Terminals IDENTIFYING CONNECTORS Knowing the connector manufacturer is helpful when trying to locating the correct connector repair procedure. There are many different connector designs used on GM vehicles and it is sometimes difficult to identify the connector manufacturer. The information in this document should help with the identification of connector manufactures. The following connector manufacturers make most of the connectors found in GM vehicles: AFL/EPC (Alcoa Fujikura Ltd./Engineered Plastics Components) - Bosch - Delphi - FCI (Framatome Connectors International) - JAE (Japan Aviation Electronics) - JST (Japan Solderless Terminals) Page 4931 REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. The release tab is located on the top of the wiredress cover. View of connector in released position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Page 8632 Oil Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Engine Oil Pressure Sensor and/or Switch Replacement Tools Required J 41712 Oil Pressure Switch Socket Removal Procedure 1. Remove the intake manifold. Refer to Intake Manifold Replacement. 2. Disconnect the oil pressure sensor electrical connector (1). 3. Using J 41712 or equivalent, remove the oil pressure sensor. Installation Procedure Page 4552 Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size. REPAIRING A FUSIBLE LINK IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient overload protection. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. Flat Wire Repairs FLAT WIRE REPAIRS NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced. GMLAN Wiring Repairs GMLAN WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The GM Local Area Network (GMLAN) System requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working on GMLAN connectors and terminals. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items in order to repair the GMLAN wiring: Dura Seal splice sleeves - A wire stripping tool - J 38125-8 Crimping Tool (GM P/N 12085115) - J 38125-5 Ultra Torch Special Tool (GM P/N 12085116) The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. - A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors GMLAN REPAIRS IMPORTANT: When making a repair to any GMLAN network, the original wire length after the repair must be the same length as before the repair. If the network is a twisted pair, the twist must be maintained after the repair is completed. GMLAN has 2 types of networks, low speed and high speed. Low speed GMLAN has a single wire and works at slow speeds. High speed GMLAN has 2 wires in a twisted pair and works at higher speeds. For more information on GMLAN, refer to Data Link Communications Description and Operation. GMLAN CONNECTOR TERMINAL REPAIR IMPORTANT: A service terminal can be used to replace damaged connector terminals for both high speed and low speed GMLAN systems. When making a connector terminal repair on a GMLAN high speed system with twisted pair wires, do not untwist the wires more than necessary to make the repair. The terminals in the GMLAN system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are available in the J-38125. If the individual terminals are damaged on any GMLAN connection, use the appropriate connector repair procedure in order to repair the terminal. GMLAN WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 8957 6. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by pressing on the tang. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (SENSOR) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) tool into the cavity on the lower right hand face of the connector until the terminal release tang access panel slides over. Page 6433 Connector Anatomy Connector Repairs contains a list of all connector repairs. The connector repairs are listed by the connector manufacturer and then by connector type. If the technician cannot identify the manufacturer of the connector, refer to Identifying Connectors below. Knowing the connector manufacturer will assist in finding the correct connector repair from the following list: - Connector Position Assurance Locks - Terminal Position Assurance Locks - Bosch Connectors (0.64) Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) Bosch Connectors (BSK) Bosch Connectors (ECM) - Delphi Connectors (Micro.64) Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) Delphi Connectors (12-Way) - Tyco/AMP Connectors (CM 42-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) Tyco/AMP Connectors (025 Cap) Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) - Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) - Repairing Connector Terminals IDENTIFYING CONNECTORS Knowing the connector manufacturer is helpful when trying to locating the correct connector repair procedure. There are many different connector designs used on GM vehicles and it is sometimes difficult to identify the connector manufacturer. The information in this document should help with the identification of connector manufactures. The following connector manufacturers make most of the connectors found in GM vehicles: AFL/EPC (Alcoa Fujikura Ltd./Engineered Plastics Components) - Bosch - Delphi - FCI (Framatome Connectors International) - JAE (Japan Aviation Electronics) - JST (Japan Solderless Terminals) Page 6436 - JST connectors have JST in small letters on their connectors, similar to that above. The location of the logo will vary with the connector size and style. - Kostel has an "LK" with a circle around it. These connector are usually used as a transmissions connection and are currently use on some Cadillac vehicles. Page 2637 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Start in the middle and gradually move the heat barrel to the open ends of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Heated Oxygen Sensor Wiring Repairs HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being obstructed. If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. - Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks, etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire. - Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance. - To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector. Page 2270 5. While pushing the terminal forward, insert the J 38125-24 in the release cavity above the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (43-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Page 7039 View of a typical Micro 64 connector. Depress the lock and pull the lever over and past the lock. Page 105 Built After and Including the VIN Breakpoints shown. The Generation (Gen) 6.1 OnStar(R) system found in these vehicles has the capability to change the default English voice recognition to French or Spanish. Changing the language of the OnStar(R) system will change the following features to the language you select: Voice recognition command prompts will be played in the language selected. The voice recognition system will only recognize commands given in the selected language. Once completed, this process completely changes all voice recognition and voice commands of the OnStar(R) system. The process will need to be repeated in its entirety to change to a different language, including English. Page 2104 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. 4. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front of the connector. Page 4600 difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Bosch Connectors (ECM) BOSCH CONNECTORS (ECM) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the assist lever on the top of the connector. Move the assist lever to the forward position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 4160 Oil Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Engine Oil Pressure Sensor and/or Switch Replacement Tools Required J 41712 Oil Pressure Switch Socket Removal Procedure 1. Remove the intake manifold. Refer to Intake Manifold Replacement. 2. Disconnect the oil pressure sensor electrical connector (1). 3. Using J 41712 or equivalent, remove the oil pressure sensor. Installation Procedure Page 7151 vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide variety of actions, including: - Wiggling the harness - Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting - Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector - Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation - Relocating a harness or wires All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. Another option is, with the component commanded ON and OFF by the scan tool, move related connectors and wiring and observe the component operation. With the engine running, move related connectors and wiring while monitoring engine operation. If harness or connector movement affects the data displayed, component/system operation, or engine operation, inspect and repair the harness/connections as necessary. You may need to load the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these cases you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide good results as well. There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions, along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the circuit to these kinds of conditions. SALT WATER SPRAY Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture. Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5 percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously. HIGH TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070. Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault condition. The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis. This option does not allow for the same control, however. LOW TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect. If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to -18°C (0°F) from one end and +71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized cooling needs. Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or components in an effort to duplicate the concern. DUPLICATING FAILURE CONDITIONS - If none of the previous tests are successful, attempt to duplicate and/or capture the failure conditions. Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, where applicable, contains the conditions that were present when the DTC set. 1. Review and record Freeze Frame/Failure Records data. 2. Clear the DTCs using the scan tool. 3. Turn the key to OFF and wait 15 seconds. 4. Operate the vehicle under the same conditions that were noted in Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, as closely as possible. The vehicle must also be operating within the Conditions for Running the DTC. Refer to Conditions for Running the DTC in the supporting text if a DTC is being diagnosed. 5. Monitor DTC Status for the DTC being tested. The scan tool will indicate Ran, when the enabling conditions have been satisfied long enough for the DTC to run. The scan tool will also indicate whether the DTC passed or failed. - An alternate method is to drive the vehicle with the DMM connected to a suspected circuit. An abnormal reading on the DMM when the concern occurs, may help you locate the concern. Measuring Frequency Page 4964 Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size. REPAIRING A FUSIBLE LINK IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient overload protection. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. Flat Wire Repairs FLAT WIRE REPAIRS NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced. GMLAN Wiring Repairs GMLAN WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The GM Local Area Network (GMLAN) System requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working on GMLAN connectors and terminals. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items in order to repair the GMLAN wiring: Dura Seal splice sleeves - A wire stripping tool - J 38125-8 Crimping Tool (GM P/N 12085115) - J 38125-5 Ultra Torch Special Tool (GM P/N 12085116) The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. - A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors GMLAN REPAIRS IMPORTANT: When making a repair to any GMLAN network, the original wire length after the repair must be the same length as before the repair. If the network is a twisted pair, the twist must be maintained after the repair is completed. GMLAN has 2 types of networks, low speed and high speed. Low speed GMLAN has a single wire and works at slow speeds. High speed GMLAN has 2 wires in a twisted pair and works at higher speeds. For more information on GMLAN, refer to Data Link Communications Description and Operation. GMLAN CONNECTOR TERMINAL REPAIR IMPORTANT: A service terminal can be used to replace damaged connector terminals for both high speed and low speed GMLAN systems. When making a connector terminal repair on a GMLAN high speed system with twisted pair wires, do not untwist the wires more than necessary to make the repair. The terminals in the GMLAN system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are available in the J-38125. If the individual terminals are damaged on any GMLAN connection, use the appropriate connector repair procedure in order to repair the terminal. GMLAN WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 4993 20. Extract a portion of the ECT sensor harness wiring and connector from the protective conduit. Cut off the ECT sensor harness connector and wiring. 21. Determine a routing path for the ECT sensor jumper harness wires so that they can be secured TO or WITHIN an existing protective conduit. Note This step is to set up and verify the length of wiring that is required before cutting. 22. Route the ECT sensor jumper wires and then enclose them in their own protective conduit in order to VERIFY the length that is required. 23. Cut the ECT sensor jumper wires to the appropriate length. Note Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splice or connector. 24. Splice the ECT sensor jumper wires to the ORIGINAL ECT HARNESS LOCATION using DuraSeal weatherproof splices. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves in SI. Note Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splice or connector. 25. Splice the ECT sensor jumper wires to the ECT SENSOR HARNESS CONNECTOR using DuraSeal weatherproof splices. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves in SI. 26. Connect the ECT sensor harness connector to the ECT sensor. 27. Secure the ECT sensor jumper wires that are in their own protective conduit TO or WITHIN the existing harness conduit using tie straps. Important You MUST run the engine at the specified RPM and until it reaches normal operating temperature and then allow it to idle as indicated in SI. The engine MUST then be allowed to cool down in order to top off the coolant level as needed. 28. Fill the cooling system to the proper level. Refer to Cooling System Draining and Filling in SI. 29. Pressure test the cooling system. Refer to Cooling System Leak Testing in SI. 30. Use a scan tool to clear any DTCs. Relocating the Engine Coolant Heater Cord Important For reference, the procedure and graphics that are shown are from a Chevrolet Silverado, but are similar for the other vehicles listed above. 1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Ask the customer where they would prefer the extension cord to exit from the engine compartment in order to determine the required extension cord length. 3. Obtain an extension cord with the following features: - 120 volt - 14/3 gauge - 15A capacity - Three prong - Polarized plug and receptacle - Chemical resistant - Grounded terminals - Designed for use in a cold outdoor environment - Outer jacket resistant to deterioration from moisture, abrasion and exposure to sunlight - Maximum length of 2.5-3 m (8-10 ft) 4. Release enough of the clips that retain the engine coolant heater cord to the vehicle to provide the necessary length for repositioning. 5. Apply dielectric grease to the electrical contacts of the heater cord receptacle and the extension cord plug to prevent corrosion. Use GM P/N 12345579 (in Canada, use P/N 10953481) or an equivalent. 6. Connect the heater cord receptacle to the extension cord plug and wipe OFF any excess grease. Page 6063 Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Page 8141 6. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs located on the opposite side of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover at the connector end and pry up. 7. Remove the dress cover. 8. Cut the tie wrap on the wire bundle. 9. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting a small flat-bladed tool into the small slot in the end of the slider and pushing on the TPA until it comes out of the connector. When the TPA exits the opposite side of the connector, gasp the TPA and pull it completely out of the connector. 10. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 5959 5. Insert the J 38125-557 (GM P/N 12122378) into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 6. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Connector Position Assurance Locks CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of the connector. CPAs are used in various connectors throughout the vehicle. CPAs are also used in all SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals, of the connector. Connector Repairs CONNECTOR REPAIRS Page 6082 IMPORTANT: Ensure that the dress cover and connector body are both in the released position before reassembling. Failure to do so may cause damage to the connector and component. Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (0.64) BOSCH CONNECTORS (0.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While pressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock until the lever is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Pull the rubber boot that covers the wires back to expose the end of the connector dress cover. 4. Place the connector locking lever in the center of the connector. 5. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs that are on the wire end of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover and connector body and pry up. Page 6089 - JST connectors have JST in small letters on their connectors, similar to that above. The location of the logo will vary with the connector size and style. - Kostel has an "LK" with a circle around it. These connector are usually used as a transmissions connection and are currently use on some Cadillac vehicles. Page 5493 If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs SIR/SRS WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS, and the wiring components, such as connectors and terminals. IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system terminals. Use either an SIR/SRS pigtail or a terminated lead from the SIR Repair Kit Tray. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves, in order to repair the SIR/SRS wiring - A special crimping tool - A heat torch - An instruction manual The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides the necessary low resistance contact integrity for these sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors SIR/SRS CONNECTOR REPAIR (PLASTIC BODY AND TERMINAL METAL PIN) The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made with a special plating. This plating provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. Use the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit for repairing SIR/SRS terminals and connectors. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the repair kit. The J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit contains: Various terminated leads for sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) terminal replacement - Various connector positive assurance (CPA) locks for SIR/SRS connectors - Base of steering column pigtail connectors part number 12085514 - Yellow vinyl electrical tape Pigtail repair packs are available for SIR/SRS connectors with eight or less terminals. Only the connector body is available for connectors with more than eight terminals. The terminated leads in the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit can be used to replace damaged terminals when replacing the connector body. SIR/SRS COMPONENT WIRE PIGTAIL REPAIR IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails. A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device, not by a connector. If a wiring pigtail is damaged, you must replace the entire component, with pigtail. The inflatable restraint steering wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component. SIR/SRS WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 6602 If a wire is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm, etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except coaxial. - Do not use the DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent American wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 778 Engine Control Module (ECM) C2 (Pin 11 To 54) Page 2499 2. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully push the terminal position assurance (TPA) towards the face of the connector on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA is fragile and may break if not done carefully. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. 3. Use the J 38125-215 tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 2371 5. Once the nose piece retainers are relaxed, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should raise slightly. 6. On the opposite side of the nose piece, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should release completely. If the nose piece does not come off, repeat the procedure on the opposite side. Page 6939 4. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the rear of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. 5. Once the locking tabs are unlocked, slide the inner connector out of the rear of the connector housing. Page 2318 If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200 DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J 39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected. IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J 39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and maximum (MAX) values measured. 1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of a suspected circuit to the other. 2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J 39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep). IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value in order to record the full change. 5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling the connections or the wiring, test driving, or performing other operations. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions. 6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9. Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist. Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections TESTING FOR INTERMITTENT CONDITIONS AND POOR CONNECTIONS TOOLS REQUIRED - J 35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit - J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit When the condition is not currently present, but is indicated in DTC history, the cause may be intermittent. An intermittent may also be the cause when there is a customer complaint, but the symptom cannot be duplicated. Refer to the Symptom Table of the system that is suspect of causing the condition before trying to locate an intermittent condition. Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the following items: Wiring broken inside the insulation - Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector - Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself, and corrosion in the wire to terminal contact area, etc. - Pierced or damaged insulation can allow moisture to enter the wiring causing corrosion. The conductor can corrode inside the insulation, with little visible evidence. Look for swollen and stiff sections of wire in the suspect circuits. - Wiring which has been pinched, cut, or its insulation rubbed through may cause an intermittent open or short as the bare area touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle. - Wiring that comes in contact with hot or exhaust components - Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required, in order to verify the customer concern. - Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. - Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis and Vehicle Data Recorder operation. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any inline connectors before replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation. Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination, usually in the underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit. Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper adapter. Always use the J 35616 when probing connectors. Other causes of terminal deformation are improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT IN BUSSED ELECTRICAL CENTERS (BEC) Page 4003 1. Route the drive belt around all the pulleys except the generator pulley. 2. Install the breaker bar with hex-head socket to the belt tensioner bolt. 3. Rotate the belt tensioner clockwise in order to relieve the tension on the belt. 4. Install the drive belt on the generator pulley. 5. Slowly release the tension on the belt tensioner. 6. Remove the breaker bar and socket from the belt tensioner bolt. 7. Inspect the drive belt for proper installation and alignment. 8. Install the air cleaner resonator outlet duct. Refer to Air Cleaner Resonator Outlet Duct Replacement. Page 7194 REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. The release tab is located on the top of the wiredress cover. View of connector in released position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Page 1360 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Kostal Connectors KOSTAL CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 5687 - In some cases Delphi will actually be printed on the connector. If Delphi is not printed on the connector, look for PED. In both cases there is no specific orientation for Delphi or PED and they can appear anywhere on the connector. - FCI connectors may have the FCI logo on their connectors. The logo is the letters FCI with an "A" above it. - JAE connector have JAE in small letters on their connectors. Page 5321 2. Locate the nose piece locking tabs that are positioned on the side of the connector nose piece. The connector nose piece acts as a terminal positive assurance (TPA) and may be referred to as such. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to push in one of the locking tabs while gently pulling on the same side of the nose piece. 4. Repeat the procedure for the other locking tab and remove the nose piece. 5. Remove the wire dress cover. The following is a general procedure for wire dress cover removal. Use this procedure as a guide, some dress cover removal procedures may vary. 6. Use fingers to squeeze the 2 locking legs of the cover. Page 4928 Release the lower wiredress cover locking tab. Release the upper wiredress cover locking tab. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. Page 278 Front Passenger Door Module (FPDM) C3 (Outside Rearview Mirror Passenger) (DS3/DL2) Page 3706 Page 2570 View of connector in released position. 4. Disconnect the connector from the component. 5. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Release the rear lower half of the wiredress cover. Page 2652 Knock Sensor: Connector Views Engine Controls Connector End Views Knock Sensor (KS) 1 - Left Knock Sensor (KS) 2 - Right Page 6327 - Yazaki has a wedge or arrow shape, similar to that shown. Delphi Connectors (Micro .64) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro 64 connectors. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. The lever lock may be located on the top or sides of the wire dress cover. Page 1200 4. Compare the fuel tank serial number printed on the fuel tank label (1) to the fuel tank serial number (sequencing) range shown. ^ If the serial number of the tank is not within the ranges above, lower the vehicle. No further action is required. ^ If the serial number of the tank is within the ranges above, remove and replace the fuel sender assembly. Proceed to Step 5 in this bulletin. 5. Remove the fuel tank from the vehicle. Remove the fuel sender assembly from the fuel tank. Refer to Fuel Sender Assembly Replacement in SI. Notice: Ensure that the fuel level sensor pigtail wires are routed through the anti-chafing conduit of the fuel sender assembly to avoid damaging the fuel level sensor pigtail wires. Route the fuel level sensor pigtail wires through the anti-chafing conduit the same way the wires were routed in the old fuel sender assembly. 6. Remove the fuel level sensor from the old fuel sender assembly and install it to the new fuel sender assembly. Refer to Fuel Level Sensor Replacement in SI. 7. Install the fuel sender assembly into the fuel tank and install the fuel tank. Refer to Fuel Sender Assembly Replacement in SI. 8. Lower the vehicle. Claim Information - GM and Saab Canada Only For vehicles repaired under this service update, use the table. Claim Information - US Saab Only Page 3290 8. Insert the J 38125-213 into the small terminal release hole on the nose piece and gently pull on the back of the wire. 9. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Repairing Connector Terminals REPAIRING CONNECTOR TERMINALS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following: Push to Seat terminals - Pull to Seat terminals Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your terminal repair. The J-38125 contains further information. 1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.For cable seal terminals, remove the seal. 2. Apply the correct cable seal per gage size of the wire, if used.Slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation removal. 3. Remove the insulation. 4. For sealed terminals only, align the seal with the end of the cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal.For sealed terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal. 6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.For sealed terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable. 8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals excepting Micro-Pack 100.64 size. Soldering Micro-Pack 100 World terminals may damage the terminal. Sumitomo Connectors SUMITOMO CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 7843 Page 5030 Catalytic Converter: Service and Repair Catalytic Converter Replacement (5.3L and 6.0L Engines) Removal Procedure 1. Raise and suitably support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. Notice: Refer to Heated Oxygen and Oxygen Sensor Notice. Notice: Refer to Excessive Force and Oxygen Sensor Notice. 2. Unscrew both front heated oxygen sensor (HO2S) sensors (1) from the catalytic converter. 3. Unscrew both rear HO2S sensors (2) from the catalytic converter. 4. Remove the rear propeller shaft. Refer to Rear Propeller Shaft Replacement. 5. If equipped with four wheel drive (4WD), Remove the front propeller shaft. Refer to Front Propeller Shaft Replacement. 6. Support the transmission with a transmission jack. 7. Remove the transmission support. Refer to Transmission Support Replacement. 8. Remove the exhaust muffler nuts. Page 859 Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. FCI Connectors FCI CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 2760 Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Sensor Replacement Tire Pressure Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Raise the vehicle on a suitable support. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 2. Remove the tire/wheel assembly from the vehicle. Refer to Tire and Wheel Removal and Installation. Important: Before the tire is removed from the wheel, note the following items to avoid tire pressure sensor damage upon tire dismounting. ^ Place the sensors cap and valve on a dry clean surface after removal. The cap is aluminum and the valve is nickel plated to prevent corrosion and are not to be substituted with a cap or valve made of any other material. ^ When separating the tire bead from the wheel, position the bead breaking fixture 90 degrees from the valve stem. ^ Position the mounting/dismounting head so the tire iron, or pry bar can be inserted slightly clockwise of the sensor body when prying the tire bead up and over the mounting/dismounting head. ^ Using the tire machine, rotate the tire/wheel assembly clockwise when transferring the tire bead to the outside of the wheel rim. ^ Repeat items for inner bead. Remove the tire from the wheel. Refer to Tire Mounting and Dismounting. Important: If any tire sealant is noted upon tire dismounting, remove all residual liquid sealant from the inside of the tire and wheel surfaces. 3. Remove the tire pressure sensor nut. 4. Remove the tire pressure sensor. Installation Procedure 1. Clean any dirt or debris from the grommet sealing area. 2. Insert the sensor in the wheel hole with the air passage facing away from the wheel. Specifications Camshaft Bearing: Specifications Camshaft Bearing Bore 1 and 5 Diameter ........................................................................................................................................................... 59.58-59.63 mm (2.345-2.347 in) 2 and 4 Diameter ........................................................................................................................................................... 59.08-59.13 mm (2.325-2.327 in) 3 Diameter ..................................................................................... ............................................................................... 58.58-58.63 mm (2.306-2.308 in) Page 2841 What corrected the customer concern and was the repair verified? Please Explain: ............. Disclaimer Page 405 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Kostal Connectors KOSTAL CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 2119 4. Once the front 2 locks are unlocked, lift the front of the dress cover and pull it forward. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the small slot on the TPA and pushing down until the TPA releases. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to angle or rock the J 38125-21 tool when inserting it into the connector or the tool may break. Insert the J 38125-21 (GM P/N 15381651-2) tool into the round canal between the terminals cavities at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to repair Micro 64 connector terminals. The Micro 64 connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-64 (M jaw) was developed to crimp Micro 64 terminals. The J 38125-64 crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. The J 38125-64 crimping tool is also designed to crimp both the wire and the insulation at the same time. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro 64 terminals. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. 1. Cut the wire as close to the damaged terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. Page 1509 If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the DuraSeal splice sleeves. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: - Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. - Do not use the crimp and DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 to crimp DuraSeal splice sleeve. In order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 2417 Page 8519 - A control module from another vehicle is installed. - Revised software/calibration files have been released for this vehicle. - IMPORTANT: DO NOT re-program the control module with the SAME software/calibration files that are already present in the control module. This is not an effective repair for any type of concern. Verify that the control module contains the correct software/calibration. If incorrect programming is found, reprogram the control module with the most current software/calibration. Refer to Control Module References for replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Testing for Short to Ground TESTING FOR SHORT TO GROUND NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 4. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit. With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is a short to ground in the circuit. Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2. Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). - When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. - If the DMM does not display voltage 4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is shorted. Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A DIGITAL MULTIMETER NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the powertrain control module (PCM), should only be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200 Digital Multimeter (DMM). The J 39200 instruction manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminage even though voltage is present. The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity. IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading. Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the measurement. Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 04-06-04-054B Date: November 18, 2010 Subject: Info - Non-GM Parts and Accessories (Aftermarket) Models: 2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years and update to the new U.S. Fixed Operation Manager (FOM) and Canada Warranty Manager (WM) names. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 04-06-04-054A (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). The recent rise and expansion of companies selling non-GM parts and accessories has made it necessary to issue this reminder to dealers regarding GM's policy on the use and installation of these aftermarket components. When a dealer is performing a repair under the New Vehicle Limited Warranty, they are required to use only genuine GM or GM-approved parts and accessories. This applies to all warranty repairs, special policy repairs or any repairs paid for by GM. Parts and accessories advertised as being "the same" as parts manufactured by GM, but not sold through GM, do not qualify for use in warranty repairs, special policy repairs or any repairs paid for by GM. During a warranty repair, if a GM original equipment part is not available through GM Customer Care and Aftersales (GM CC&A;), ACDelco(R) distributors, other GM dealers or approved sources, the dealer is to obtain comparable, non-GM parts and clearly indicate, in detail, on the repair order the circumstances surrounding why non-GM parts were used. The dealer must give customers written notice, prior to the sale or service, that such parts or accessories are not marketed or warranted by General Motors. It should also be noted that dealers modifying new vehicles and installing equipment, parts and accessories obtained from sources not authorized by GM are responsible for complying with the National Traffic and Motor Vehicle Safety Act. Certain non-approved parts or assemblies, installed by the dealer or its agent not authorized by GM, may result in a change to the vehicle's design characteristics and may affect the vehicle's ability to conform to federal law. Dealers must fully understand that non-GM approved parts may not have been validated, tested or certified for use. This puts the dealer at risk for potential liability in the event of a part or vehicle failure. If a GM part failure occurs as the result of the installation or use of a non-GM approved part, the warranty will not be honored. A good example of non-authorized modification of vehicles is the result of an ever increasing supply of aftermarket devices available to the customer, which claim to increase the horsepower and torque of the Duramax(TM) Diesel Engines. These include the addition of, but are not limited to one or more of the following modifications: - Propane injection - Nitrous oxide injection - Additional modules (black boxes) that connect to the vehicle wiring systems - Revised engine calibrations downloaded for the engine control module - Calibration modules which connect to the vehicle diagnostic connector - Modification to the engine turbocharger waste gate Although the installation of these devices, or modification of vehicle components, can increase engine horsepower and torque, they may also negatively affect the engine emissions, reliability and/or durability. In addition, other powertrain components, such as transmissions, universal joints, drive shafts, and front/rear axle components, can be stressed beyond design safety limits by the installation of these devices. General Motors does not support or endorse the use of devices or modifications that, when installed, increase the engine horsepower and torque. It is because of these unknown stresses, and the potential to alter reliability, durability and emissions performance, that GM has adopted a policy that prevents any UNAUTHORIZED dealer warranty claim submissions to any remaining warranty coverage, to the powertrain and driveline components whenever the presence of a non-GM (aftermarket) calibration is confirmed - even if the non-GM control module calibration is subsequently removed. Refer to the latest version of Bulletin 09-06-04-026 (V8 Gas Engines) or 06-06-01-007 (Duramax(TM) Diesel Engines) for more information on dealer requirements for calibration verification. These same policies apply as they relate to the use of non-GM accessories. Damage or failure from the use or installation of a non-GM accessory will not be covered under warranty. Failure resulting from the alteration or modification of the vehicle, including the cutting, welding or disconnecting of the vehicle's original equipment parts and components will void the warranty. Additionally, dealers will NOT be reimbursed or compensated by GM in the event of any legal inquiry at either the local, state or federal level that Page 6349 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Kostal Connectors KOSTAL CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 7492 11. Insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) into the 2 triangular cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 12. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE 1. Prior to installation the terminal must be aligned so the (1) coding lugs align with the (2) coding grooves on the connector. 2. Once the terminal is aligned, slide the terminal into the cavity until the retainer has engaged in the cavity of the connector. 3. Slide the TPA in the connector body and seat it using a small flat bladed tool. The TPA is seated when it is flush with the contact housing. 4. Secure the wires to the connector body using a tie wrap and replace the dress cover and grommet. Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) BOSCH CONNECTORS (2.8 JPT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Pull out the slider on the connector position assurance (CPA) until it is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 7671 3. Ensure that the terminal release tang access panel is in the correct location to access the terminals. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) into the terminal release tang access slot located behind the access panel of the connector and press down on the terminal while carefully pulling the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Tyco/AMP Connectors (0.25 Cap) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (025 CAP) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component by pressing down on the connector position assurance (CPA). Page 3681 Jump Starting: Service and Repair Jump Starting in Case of Emergency Caution: Batteries produce explosive gases. Batteries contain corrosive acid. Batteries supply levels of electrical current high enough to cause burns. Therefore, in order to reduce the risk of personal injury while working near a battery, observe the following guidelines: * Always shield your eyes. * Avoid leaning over the battery whenever possible. * Do not expose the battery to open flames or sparks. * Do not allow battery acid to contact the eyes or the skin. - Flush any contacted areas with water immediately and thoroughly. - Get medical help. Notice: This vehicle has a 12 volt, negative ground electrical system. Make sure the vehicle or equipment being used to jump start the engine is also 12 volt, negative ground. Use of any other type of system will damage the vehicle's electrical components. 1. Position the vehicle with the booster battery so that the jumper cables will reach. * Do not let the 2 vehicles touch. * Make sure that the jumper cables do not have loose ends, or missing insulation. 2. Place an automatic transmission in PARK. If equipped with a manual transmission, place in NEUTRAL and set the parking brake. 3. Turn OFF all electrical loads on both vehicles that are not needed. Leave the hazard flashers ON, if required. 4. Turn OFF the ignition on both vehicles. Important: Some vehicles have a battery remote positive stud. ALWAYS use the battery remote positive stud in order to give or to receive a jump start. 5. Connect the red positive (+) cable to the battery positive (+) terminal (2) of the vehicle with the discharged battery. 6. Connect the red positive (+) cable to the positive (+) terminal (1) of the booster battery. 7. Connect the black negative (-) cable to the negative (-) terminal (3) of the booster battery. Caution: Do not connect a jumper cable directly to the negative terminal of a discharged battery to prevent sparking and possible explosion of battery gases. 8. The final connection is made to a heavy, unpainted metal engine part (4) of the vehicle with the discharged battery. This final attachment must be at least 46 cm (18 in) away from the dead battery. 9. Start the engine of the vehicle that is providing the boost and perform the following: * Turn OFF all accessories. * Raise the engine RPM to approximately 1,500 RPM for 5 minutes Notice: Never operate the starter motor more than 15 seconds at a time without pausing in order to allow it to cool for at least 2 minutes. Overheating will damage the starter motor. 10. Crank the engine of the vehicle with the discharged battery. If the engine does not crank or cranks too slowly, perform the following: * Turn the ignition OFF. * Allow the booster vehicle engine to run at approximately 1,500 RPM for an additional 5 minutes. * Attempt to start the engine of the vehicle with the discharged battery. 11. After the engine of the vehicle with the discharged battery starts, remove the jumper cables as follows: Page 6304 Refer to the following table as a guide in selecting the correct test adapter for front probing connectors: Backprobe IMPORTANT: Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures. - Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector. - Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large of a test probe. - After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected, test for proper terminal contact. Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the connector. Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure SCAN TOOL SNAPSHOT PROCEDURE Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used Locations Air Injection Control Valve Relay: Locations Fuse Block - Underhood (5.3L/6.0L), Label Page 7500 View of a typical Micro 64 connector. Depress the lock and pull the lever over and past the lock. Page 8586 View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. 4. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers CIRCUIT PROTECTION - CIRCUIT BREAKERS A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types of circuit Page 4065 Allow at least a two hour soak time between engine OFF and start up when evaluating the tick noise. 2. Start the engine and evaluate the valve lifter tick noise. ‹› If the valve lifter tick noise is still present, replace all 16 valve lifters. Refer to Valve Lifter Replacement in SI. Parts Information Note A V8 AFM engine requires 8 AFM lifters and 8 non-AFM lifters for a total of 16 lifters. Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use: Warranty Information (Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 6405 Page 3439 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches, and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original. - The wires insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the possibility of fuel contact. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1). 5. Select the proper duraseal splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool. Refer to the Crimp and Seal Splice Table. 6. Place the duraseal splice sleeve in the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115) crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 7. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to hold the duraseal splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 8. Insert the wires into the duraseal splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel in order to prevent the wire from passing through the splice (3). 9. Close the handles of the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115), until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is applied to the splice sleeve. 10. Shrink the insulation around the splice. - Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. - Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Splicing Inline Harness Diodes SPLICING INLINE HARNESS DIODES Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure. 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode. 2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool. 5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode. Page 5942 Refer to the following table as a guide in selecting the correct test adapter for front probing connectors: Backprobe IMPORTANT: Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures. - Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector. - Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large of a test probe. - After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected, test for proper terminal contact. Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the connector. Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure SCAN TOOL SNAPSHOT PROCEDURE Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used Page 6984 Body Control Module (BCM) C2 Page 5254 Engine Control Module: Service Precautions Powertrain Control Module and Electrostatic Discharge Notice Notice: Do not touch the connector pins or soldered components on the circuit board in order to prevent possible electrostatic discharge (ESD) damage to the PCM. Page 6985 Body Control Module: Diagrams Body Control Module (BCM) C3 Body Control Module (BCM) C3 Page 6134 Release the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the blue locking tabs on both ends of the connector. Gently slide the TPA up to the released position on both ends. 6. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-13A (GM P/N 12031876-1) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. Page 5172 5. Insert the J 38125-557 (GM P/N 12122378) into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 6. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Connector Position Assurance Locks CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of the connector. CPAs are used in various connectors throughout the vehicle. CPAs are also used in all SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals, of the connector. Connector Repairs CONNECTOR REPAIRS Locations Knock Sensor: Locations Engine Controls Component Views Lower Left Side of Engine - Rear 1 - G108 2 - Knock Sensor (KS) 1 - Left 3 - Engine 4 - G107 5 - Engine Harness Lower Right Side of the Engine - Rear Page 6128 2. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 4544 5. While pushing the terminal forward, insert the J 38125-24 in the release cavity above the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (43-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Page 6253 6. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by pressing on the tang. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (SENSOR) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) tool into the cavity on the lower right hand face of the connector until the terminal release tang access panel slides over. Page 2496 View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. View of the release tool being used for the smaller terminals. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (2-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 6519 Utility/Van Zoning UTILITY/VAN ZONING Page 8967 breakers are used. CIRCUIT BREAKER This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high current is removed. POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) CIRCUIT BREAKER This type greatly increases its resistance when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker will re-close within a second or 2. Circuit Protection - Fuses CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSES The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and examine the element in the fuse for an open (2). If not broken (1), also check for continuity using a DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one of equal current rating. Circuit Protection - Fusible Links CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSIBLE LINKS Page 7482 Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. For connectors with a bolt in the dress cover, turn the bolt counterclockwise to remove the connector from the component. 2. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. Page 7099 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches, and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original. - The wires insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the possibility of fuel contact. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1). 5. Select the proper duraseal splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool. Refer to the Crimp and Seal Splice Table. 6. Place the duraseal splice sleeve in the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115) crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 7. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to hold the duraseal splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 8. Insert the wires into the duraseal splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel in order to prevent the wire from passing through the splice (3). 9. Close the handles of the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115), until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is applied to the splice sleeve. 10. Shrink the insulation around the splice. - Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. - Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Splicing Inline Harness Diodes SPLICING INLINE HARNESS DIODES Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure. 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode. 2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool. 5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode. Page 422 6. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by pressing on the tang. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (SENSOR) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) tool into the cavity on the lower right hand face of the connector until the terminal release tang access panel slides over. Page 6188 vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide variety of actions, including: - Wiggling the harness - Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting - Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector - Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation - Relocating a harness or wires All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. Another option is, with the component commanded ON and OFF by the scan tool, move related connectors and wiring and observe the component operation. With the engine running, move related connectors and wiring while monitoring engine operation. If harness or connector movement affects the data displayed, component/system operation, or engine operation, inspect and repair the harness/connections as necessary. You may need to load the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these cases you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide good results as well. There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions, along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the circuit to these kinds of conditions. SALT WATER SPRAY Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture. Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5 percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously. HIGH TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070. Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault condition. The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis. This option does not allow for the same control, however. LOW TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect. If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to -18°C (0°F) from one end and +71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized cooling needs. Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or components in an effort to duplicate the concern. DUPLICATING FAILURE CONDITIONS - If none of the previous tests are successful, attempt to duplicate and/or capture the failure conditions. Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, where applicable, contains the conditions that were present when the DTC set. 1. Review and record Freeze Frame/Failure Records data. 2. Clear the DTCs using the scan tool. 3. Turn the key to OFF and wait 15 seconds. 4. Operate the vehicle under the same conditions that were noted in Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, as closely as possible. The vehicle must also be operating within the Conditions for Running the DTC. Refer to Conditions for Running the DTC in the supporting text if a DTC is being diagnosed. 5. Monitor DTC Status for the DTC being tested. The scan tool will indicate Ran, when the enabling conditions have been satisfied long enough for the DTC to run. The scan tool will also indicate whether the DTC passed or failed. - An alternate method is to drive the vehicle with the DMM connected to a suspected circuit. An abnormal reading on the DMM when the concern occurs, may help you locate the concern. Measuring Frequency Page 4541 6. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by pressing on the tang. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (SENSOR) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) tool into the cavity on the lower right hand face of the connector until the terminal release tang access panel slides over. Page 5464 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. 4. Remove the dress cover by using a flat bladed tool to release the dress cover locking tabs and lift up on the dress cover. 5. Cut the tie wrap that holds the wires to the connector body. Page 1170 1 - Air Temperature Sensor - Lower Right Page 4458 Page 6864 Service and Repair Air Cleaner Fresh Air Duct/Hose: Service and Repair Air Cleaner Resonator Outlet Duct Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Disconnect the positive crankcase ventilation (PCV) fresh air tube (2) from the air cleaner resonator outlet duct (1). 2. Loosen the clamps at the following: * Mass air flow (MAF)/intake air temperature (IAT) sensor * Throttle body 3. Remove the air cleaner outlet duct bolt. 4. Remove the air cleaner outlet duct. Installation Procedure Page 5680 5. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove TPA from the connector. 6. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Page 7888 Remove all rust from the ground terminal, the cylinder head and the retaining nut or bolt. Position the main engine wiring harness ground terminal and install the nut or bolt. Tighten: Tighten the retaining nut or bolt to 16 N.m (12 lb ft). Apply some type of electrical moisture sealant to protect the harness terminal from further corrosion. Disclaimer Page 3273 The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors. 1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position. 4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool J 38125-10A (GM P/N 12014012-1) into the front (mating end) of the connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal through the back of the connector (2). IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector. 6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. 7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily. 10. Perform system check. Delphi Connectors (12 Way) DELPHI CONNECTORS (12-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. Page 1601 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Ensure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the Terminal Removal Procedure. Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PULL TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL If the terminal is visibly damaged or is suspected of having a faulty connection, the terminal should be replaced. Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors: 1. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) device and/or the secondary lock. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component or separate the connectors for in-line connectors. 3. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device. 4. Insert the proper pick or removal tool into the front of the connector body. 5. IMPORTANT: On connectors with more than one terminal the service loop may not be large enough to remove the terminal and crimp on a new one. If the terminal wire does not have a large enough service loop for removal, cut the wire 5 cm (2 in) behind the connector before removal. Grasp the wire at the back of the connector body and gently push the terminal out the front of the connector body. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. If the wire needed to be cut in order to remove the terminal, gently push a small length of the same size wire through the back of the connector cavity until there is enough wire exposed in order to crimp on a new terminal. If the wire was not cut, cut the existing wire as close to the old terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 4. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. TERMINAL INSTALLATION 1. Align the terminal and pull the wire from the back of the connector in order to seat the terminal. 2. If necessary, cut the new wire to proper length and splice with existing circuit. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. 3. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply dielectric grease to the connector. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PUSH TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 6599 View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. 4. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers CIRCUIT PROTECTION - CIRCUIT BREAKERS A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types of circuit Page 4594 Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested: - Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. - Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a component or to other harnesses. - If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A TEST LAMP TOOLS REQUIRED J 35616-200 Test Light - Probe Kit NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminate even though voltage is present. The J 35616-200 is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair of leads. To properly operate this tool use the following procedures. When testing for voltage: 1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested. When testing for ground: 1. Attach one lead to battery positive voltage. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where ground should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is ground at the point being tested. Using Connector Test Adapters USING CONNECTOR TEST ADAPTERS NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Using Fused Jumper Wires USING FUSED JUMPER WIRES TOOLS REQUIRED J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged. The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested. AFL/ECP Connectors AFL/EPC CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 8780 Refer to the following table as a guide in selecting the correct test adapter for front probing connectors: Backprobe IMPORTANT: Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures. - Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector. - Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large of a test probe. - After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected, test for proper terminal contact. Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the connector. Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure SCAN TOOL SNAPSHOT PROCEDURE Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used Page 7919 - HVAC Actuator - Inflatable Restraint Sensing and Diagnostic Module (SDM) - Any AIR BAG module - Seatbelt Lap Anchor Pretensioner - Seatbelt Retractor Pretensioner - An SIR system connection or connector condition resulting in the following DTCs being set: B0015, B0016, B0019, B0020, B0022, or B0023 - Powertrain Control Module (PCM) - Remote Control Door Lock Receiver (RCDLR) - Transmission Control Module (TCM) Correction Important DO NOT replace the control module, wiring or component for the following conditions: - The condition is intermittent and cannot be duplicated. - The condition is present and by disconnecting and reconnecting the connector the condition can no longer be duplicated. Use the following procedure to correct the conditions listed above. 1. Install a scan tool and perform the Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle. Retrieve and record any existing history or current DTCs from all of the control modules (refer to SI). ‹› If any DTC(s) are set, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle to identify the connector(s) of the control module/component which may be causing the condition (refer to SI). ‹› If DTCs are not set, refer to Symptoms - Vehicle to identify the connector(s) of the control module/component which may be causing the condition (refer to SI). 2. When identified, use the appropriate DTC Diagnostics, Symptoms, Schematics, Component Connector End Views and Component Locator documents to locate and disconnect the affected harness connector(s) which are causing the condition. Note Fretting corrosion looks like little dark smudges on electrical terminals and appear where the actual electrical contact is being made. In less severe cases it may be unable to be seen or identified without the use of a magnifying glass. Important DO NOT apply an excessive amount of dielectric lubricant to the connectors as shown, as hydrolock may result when attempting to mate the connectors. Use ONLY a clean nylon brush that is dedicated to the repair of the conditions in this bulletin. 3. With a one-inch nylon bristle brush, apply dielectric lubricant to both the module/component side and the harness side of the affected connector(s). 4. Reconnect the affected connector(s) and wipe away any excess lubricant that may be present. 5. Attempt to duplicate the condition by using the following information: - DTC Diagnostic Procedure - Circuit/System Description - Conditions for Running the DTC - Conditions for Setting the DTC - Diagnostic Aids - Circuit/System Verification ‹› If the condition cannot be duplicated, the repair is complete. ‹› If the condition can be duplicated, then follow the appropriate DTC, Symptom or Circuit/System Testing procedure (refer to SI). Repair Order Documentation Page 8037 MOLEX CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. 2. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. Page 1301 Specifications Harmonic Balancer - Crankshaft Pulley: Specifications Crankshaft Balancer Bolt Installation Pass to Ensure the Balancer is Completely Installed ........................................................................................................ 330 N.m (240 lb ft) First Pass Install a NEW Bolt After the Installation Pass and Tighten as Described in the First and Final Passes ............................... 50 N.m (37 lb ft) Final Pass .................................................................... .................................................................................................................................... 140 degrees Page 5007 Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagrams Engine Controls Connector End Views Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor Page 6213 - Most Molex connectors will have the Molex logo on the dresscover of the connector. In some cases the connectors may have MX followed by another letter. The third letter indicates where the connector was made. A connector with MXD is a Molex connector made in Detroit. Sumitomo has a unique symbol on their connector and possibly a part number. The symbol is similar to that of a diamond lying on its side, similar to that shown. The logo could appear anywhere but the most common place is at the wire side of the housing. Tyco/AMP has many different and unique connector designs. Some may or may not have identifiable marks on them. Page 811 Utility/Van Zoning UTILITY/VAN ZONING Page 7371 REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. The release tab is located on the top of the wiredress cover. View of connector in released position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Page 8197 View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. 4. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers CIRCUIT PROTECTION - CIRCUIT BREAKERS A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types of circuit Page 235 3. Remove the dress cover by using a flat-blade tool to release the connector locking tabs and pulling off the dress cover. 4. Relieve the tension on the nose piece retainers by inserting J-38125-12A (12094429) into the single retainer slot on the end of the nose piece and gently prying out the locking tab. Repeat the process for both of the nose piece locking tabs on the opposite side of the nose piece. Page 2643 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the DuraSeal splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of a connector. CPAs are used in all SIR System connectors and also in some connectors of other systems. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals of a connection. TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE CLIPS IMPORTANT: When making a splice in an area that may be exposed to moisture use a crimp and seal splice sleeve instead of a Splice Clip. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. Page 251 2. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully push the terminal position assurance (TPA) towards the face of the connector on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA is fragile and may break if not done carefully. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. 3. Use the J 38125-215 tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 6095 4. Once the front 2 locks are unlocked, lift the front of the dress cover and pull it forward. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the small slot on the TPA and pushing down until the TPA releases. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to angle or rock the J 38125-21 tool when inserting it into the connector or the tool may break. Insert the J 38125-21 (GM P/N 15381651-2) tool into the round canal between the terminals cavities at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to repair Micro 64 connector terminals. The Micro 64 connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-64 (M jaw) was developed to crimp Micro 64 terminals. The J 38125-64 crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. The J 38125-64 crimping tool is also designed to crimp both the wire and the insulation at the same time. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro 64 terminals. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. 1. Cut the wire as close to the damaged terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. Page 508 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the TPA. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the nose piece. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. Page 8413 TERMINAL REMOVAL Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors. 1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA) device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1). 3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 4. Gently pull the cable and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector. 5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal, refer to Terminal Repair. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3. Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector. REINSTALLING TERMINAL 1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly, refer to Wiring Repairs. 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3. Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) DELPHI CONNECTORS (WEATHER PACK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 8650 Checking Aftermarket Accessories CHECKING AFTERMARKET ACCESSORIES Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits: - CAUTION: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol. - NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice. OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol. Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the cause of the problems. Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include: Power feeds connected to points other than the battery - Antenna location - Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring - Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line - Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories. Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions INDUCING INTERMITTENT FAULT CONDITIONS TOOLS REQUIRED J 25070 Heat Gun Many intermittent open or shorted circuits are affected by harness/connector movement that is caused by vibration, engine torque, bumps/rough pavement, etc. In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness if the malfunction appears to be Page 1686 1 - Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor 2 - Knock Sensor (KS) 2 - Right 3 - Engine Harness 4 Starter 5 - Engine Page 5489 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Start in the middle and gradually move the heat barrel to the open ends of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Heated Oxygen Sensor Wiring Repairs HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being obstructed. If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. - Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks, etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire. - Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance. - To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector. Page 4339 Coolant: Fluid Type Specifications ENGINE COOLANT The cooling system in your vehicle is filled with DEX-COOL engine coolant. This coolant is designed to remain in your vehicle for 5 years or 150,000 miles (240 000 km), whichever occurs first, if you add only DEX-COOL extended life coolant. A 50/50 mixture of clean, drinkable water and DEX-COOL coolant will: - Give freezing protection down to -34°F (-37°C). - Give boiling protection up to 265°F (129°C). - Protect against rust and corrosion. - Help keep the proper engine temperature. - Let the warning lights and gages work as they should. NOTICE: Using coolant other than DEX-COOL may cause premature engine, heater core or radiator corrosion. In addition, the engine coolant may require changing sooner, at 30,000 miles (50 000 km) or 24 months, whichever occurs first. Any repairs would not be covered by your warranty. Always use DEX-COOL (silicate-free) coolant in your vehicle. WHAT TO USE Use a mixture of one-half clean, drinkable water and one-half DEX-COOL coolant which won't damage aluminum parts. If you use this coolant mixture, you don't need to add anything else. CAUTION: Adding only plain water to your cooling system can be dangerous. Plain water, or some other liquid such as alcohol, can boil before the proper coolant mixture will. Your vehicle's coolant warning system is set for the proper coolant mixture. With plain water or the wrong mixture, your engine could get too hot but you would not get the overheat warning. Your engine could catch fire and you or others could be burned. Use a 50/50 mixture of clean, drinkable water and DEX-COOL coolant. NOTICE: If you use an improper coolant mixture, your engine could overheat and be badly damaged. The repair cost would not be covered by your warranty. Too much water in the mixture can freeze and crack the engine, radiator, heater core and other parts. If you have to add coolant more than four times a year, check your cooling system. NOTICE: If you use the proper coolant, you do not have to add extra inhibitors or additives which claim to improve the system. These can be harmful. Engine - MIL ON P0116/P1400 Set In Very Cold Temps Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Customer Interest Engine - MIL ON P0116/P1400 Set In Very Cold Temps TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 10-06-04-008A Date: January 24, 2011 Subject: Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) Illuminated at Very Cold Ambient Temperatures When Using Engine Coolant Heater, DTC P0116 and/or P1400 Set (Relocate Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor and Engine Coolant Heater Cord) Models: 2006-2007 Buick Rainier 2009 Buick LaCrosse Super, Allure Super (Canada Only) 2006-2010 Cadillac Escalade 2006-2007 Chevrolet Monte Carlo 2006-2009 Chevrolet Impala SS, TrailBlazer 2006-2010 Chevrolet Avalanche, Express, Silverado Tahoe 2006-2009 GMC Envoy 2006-2010 GMC Savana, Sierra, Yukon 2006-2008 Pontiac Grand Prix 2006-2009 Saab 9-7X Equipped with V8 Engine RPO LC9, LH6, LH8, LH9, L76, LS2, LS4, LFA, LZ1, L92, L94, L9H or L20, L96, LMF, LMG, LY2, LY5, LY6 Please Refer to GMVIS Attention: To properly correct this condition, you must follow both of the procedures to relocate the ECT sensor and the engine coolant heater cord. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add cast iron block engine RPOs and to update the Warranty Information coverage period. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 10-06-04-008 (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). Condition Some customers may comment that the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) illuminates after starting the vehicle when they were using the engine coolant heater in very cold ambient temperatures. This usually occurs in a range of -23 to -40°C (-10 to -40°F) or colder. The technician may observe on a scan tool DTC P0116 and/or P1400 set as Current or in History. Cause This condition may be caused by the engine control module (ECM) determining that the ignition OFF time requirement has been met at start-up and interpreting the temperature difference between the engine coolant temperature (ECT) sensor and the intake air temperature (IAT) sensor as being outside of a calibrated range. Correction Important DO NOT replace the ECM for this condition. Relocating the ECT Sensor 1. Turn ON the ignition with the engine OFF. 2. Perform the diagnostic system check - vehicle. Refer to Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle in SI. ‹› If DTC P0116 and/or P1400 are set and the customer WAS using the engine coolant heater, proceed to Step 3. ‹› If DTC P0116 and/or P1400 are set and the customer WAS NOT using the engine coolant heater, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle in SI. 3. Turn OFF the ignition. Warning To avoid being burned, do not remove the radiator cap or surge tank cap while the engine is hot. The cooling system will release scalding fluid and steam Page 7502 Depress the locks that are located on both sides of the wiredress cover and pull the lever over and past the locks. View of the connector when released from the component. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the front of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool push down on one of the locking tabs and pull the cover up until the dress cover releases. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. Page 8511 Checking Aftermarket Accessories CHECKING AFTERMARKET ACCESSORIES Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits: - CAUTION: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol. - NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice. OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol. Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the cause of the problems. Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include: Power feeds connected to points other than the battery - Antenna location - Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring - Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line - Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories. Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions INDUCING INTERMITTENT FAULT CONDITIONS TOOLS REQUIRED J 25070 Heat Gun Many intermittent open or shorted circuits are affected by harness/connector movement that is caused by vibration, engine torque, bumps/rough pavement, etc. In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness if the malfunction appears to be Page 5186 7. Apply pressure and gently rock the cover until one locking leg is unseated. 8. Continue to apply pressure and rock the cover until the second locking leg is unseated. Repeat procedure for the other side of the dress cover and remove the cover. 9. Use J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) to gently lift the terminal retaining tab while gently pulling the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 10. If the terminal is severely bent or damaged, it may be possible on some connectors to push the wire out of the front of the connector instead of Page 6682 - JST connectors have JST in small letters on their connectors, similar to that above. The location of the logo will vary with the connector size and style. - Kostel has an "LK" with a circle around it. These connector are usually used as a transmissions connection and are currently use on some Cadillac vehicles. Page 7800 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Kostal Connectors KOSTAL CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 7095 If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the DuraSeal splice sleeves. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: - Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. - Do not use the crimp and DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 to crimp DuraSeal splice sleeve. In order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 2239 TERMINAL REMOVAL Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors. 1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA) device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1). 3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 4. Gently pull the cable and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector. 5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal, refer to Terminal Repair. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3. Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector. REINSTALLING TERMINAL 1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly, refer to Wiring Repairs. 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3. Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) DELPHI CONNECTORS (WEATHER PACK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 7487 difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Bosch Connectors (ECM) BOSCH CONNECTORS (ECM) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the assist lever on the top of the connector. Move the assist lever to the forward position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 3421 Release the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the blue locking tabs on both ends of the connector. Gently slide the TPA up to the released position on both ends. 6. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-13A (GM P/N 12031876-1) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. Page 7777 - Most Molex connectors will have the Molex logo on the dresscover of the connector. In some cases the connectors may have MX followed by another letter. The third letter indicates where the connector was made. A connector with MXD is a Molex connector made in Detroit. Sumitomo has a unique symbol on their connector and possibly a part number. The symbol is similar to that of a diamond lying on its side, similar to that shown. The logo could appear anywhere but the most common place is at the wire side of the housing. Tyco/AMP has many different and unique connector designs. Some may or may not have identifiable marks on them. Page 1156 Oil Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Engine Oil Pressure Sensor and/or Switch Replacement Tools Required J 41712 Oil Pressure Switch Socket Removal Procedure 1. Remove the intake manifold. Refer to Intake Manifold Replacement. 2. Disconnect the oil pressure sensor electrical connector (1). 3. Using J 41712 or equivalent, remove the oil pressure sensor. Installation Procedure Page 5594 Release the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the blue locking tabs on both ends of the connector. Gently slide the TPA up to the released position on both ends. 6. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-13A (GM P/N 12031876-1) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. Page 4507 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert terminal into the appropriate terminal holder until it hits bottom and stops. The correct terminal holder is determined by the wire size. Also ensure that the terminals wings are pointing towards the former on the tool and the release locator. 5. Insert the stripped cable into the terminal. Insulation should be visible on both sides of the terminal insulation wings. 6. Compress the handles until the ratchet automatically releases. 7. Place the terminal into the appropriate cavity and assemble the connector. Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO-PACK 100W) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W connectors. These connectors are very similar but use different terminals and have some minor physical differences also. Page 3593 hot particles embed themselves in the chrome layer and create a small pit. If the material is allowed to sit on the wheel while it is exposed to moisture or salt, it will corrode the wheel beneath the chrome leaving a pit or small blister in the chrome. Heavy brake dust build-up should be removed from wheels by using GM Chrome Cleaner and Polish, P/N 1050173 (in Canada use 10953013). For moderate cleaning, light brake dust build-up or water spots use GM Swirl Remover Polish, P/N 12377965 (in Canada, use Meguiars Plast-X(TM) Clear Plastic Cleaner and Polish #G12310C**). After cleaning, the wheel should be waxed using GM Cleaner Wax, P/N 12377966 (in Canada, use Meguiars Cleaner Wax #M0616C**), which will help protect the wheel from brake dust and reduce adhesion of any brake dust that gets on the wheel surface. For general maintenance cleaning, PEEK Metal Polish† may be used. It will clean and shine the chrome and leave behind a wax coating that may help protect the finish. Warranty of Stardust Corroded Chrome Wheels Wheels returned with pitting or spotting as a result of neglect and brake dust build-up may be replaced one time. Important Notify the customer that this is a one time replacement. Please stress to the customer the vital importance of keeping the wheels clean and free of prolonged exposure to brake dust build-up. "GM of Canada" dealers require prior approval by the District Manager - Customer Care and Service Process (DM-CCSP). Customer Assistance and Instructions GM has looked for ways customers may improve the appearance of wheels damaged by acidic cleaners. The following product and procedure has been found to dramatically improve the appearance of stained wheels. For wheels that have milky stains caused by acidic cleaners try the following: Notice THE 3M CHROME AND METAL POLISH REQUIRED FOR THIS PROCEDURE IS AN EXTREMELY AGGRESSIVE POLISH/CLEANER. THE WHEELS MUST BE CLEANED BEFORE APPLICATION TO AVOID SCRATCHING THE WHEEL SURFACE. THIS PRODUCT WILL REDUCE THE THICKNESS OF THE CHROME PLATING ON THE WHEEL AND IF USED INCORRECTLY OR EXCESSIVELY MAY REMOVE THE CHROME PLATING ALL TOGETHER, EXPOSING A LESS BRIGHT AND BRASSY COLORED SUB-LAYER. FOLLOW INSTRUCTIONS EXACTLY. 1. Wash the wheels with vigorously with soap and water. This step will clean and may reduce wheel staining. Flood all areas of the wheel with water to rinse. 2. Dry the wheels completely. Notice Begin with a small section of the wheel and with light pressure buff off polish and examine results. ONLY apply and rub with sufficient force and time to remove enough staining that you are satisfied with the results. Some wheels may be stained to the extent that you may only achieve a 50% improvement while others may be able to be restored to the original lustre. IN ALL CASES, only apply until the results are satisfactory. 3. Apply 3M Chrome and Metal Polish #39527* with a clean terry cloth towel. As you apply the polish, the staining will be diminished. 4. When dry, buff off the polish with a clean portion of the towel. 5. Repeat application of the 3M Chrome and Metal Polish until satisfied with the results. If continued applications fail to improve the appearance further discontinue use. This procedure will improve the appearance of the wheels and may, with repeated applications, restore the finish dramatically. For wheels that exhibit spotting from road chemicals the above procedure may marginally improve the condition but will not restore the finish or remove the pitting. In this type of staining the wheel finish has actually been removed in spots and no manner of cleaning will restore the finish. †*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may be available from other sources. Parts Information Page 6581 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 5734 View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. View of the release tool being used for the smaller terminals. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (2-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 1341 Depress the locks that are located on both sides of the wiredress cover and pull the lever over and past the locks. View of the connector when released from the component. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the front of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool push down on one of the locking tabs and pull the cover up until the dress cover releases. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. Page 6662 to analyze the data during the time a vehicle condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a trigger point that you have determined. Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2 snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a first-in, first-out basis. If a third snapshot is taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost. Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types: Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice - Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200 frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not lost if the Scan Tool is powered down. The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis. The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected values by plotting 3 parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful, especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC. Testing for a Short to Voltage TESTING FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4. Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt, there is a short to voltage in the circuit. Testing for Continuity TESTING FOR CONTINUITY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6. Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit. 7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity. With a Test Lamp IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits. 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6. If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity. Testing for Electrical Intermittents TESTING FOR ELECTRICAL INTERMITTENTS Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment. - Testing for Short to Ground - Testing for Continuity - Testing for a Short to Voltage Page 8369 Page 2492 3. Ensure that the terminal release tang access panel is in the correct location to access the terminals. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) into the terminal release tang access slot located behind the access panel of the connector and press down on the terminal while carefully pulling the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Tyco/AMP Connectors (0.25 Cap) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (025 CAP) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component by pressing down on the connector position assurance (CPA). Page 1496 View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. View of the release tool being used for the smaller terminals. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (2-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 2427 MEASURING FREQUENCY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal. IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM to autorange to an appropriate range. 1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency measured. Measuring Voltage MEASURING VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit. 1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods: - Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. - Turn ON the engine. - Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls. - Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested. 3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The DMM displays the voltage measured at that point. Measuring Voltage Drop MEASURING VOLTAGE DROP NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points. Probing Electrical Connectors PROBING ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS Page 7751 Checking Aftermarket Accessories CHECKING AFTERMARKET ACCESSORIES Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits: - CAUTION: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol. - NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice. OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol. Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the cause of the problems. Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include: Power feeds connected to points other than the battery - Antenna location - Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring - Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line - Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories. Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions INDUCING INTERMITTENT FAULT CONDITIONS TOOLS REQUIRED J 25070 Heat Gun Many intermittent open or shorted circuits are affected by harness/connector movement that is caused by vibration, engine torque, bumps/rough pavement, etc. In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness if the malfunction appears to be Page 8793 5. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove TPA from the connector. 6. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Page 6177 Page 8983 Page 2151 7. Pressing the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool in the release cavity of the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and crimper in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (DOOR MODULE) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Side view of connector. View of top of connector. 1. Locate the assist lever and lock on the top of the connector. Page 4377 3. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. View showing depressing of the lever lock release tab. Page 3218 Fuse: Locations Rear Fuse Block Fuse Block - Rear, Label Page 6728 View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. View of the release tool being used for the smaller terminals. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (2-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 3605 service operation. A simple distraction or time constraint that rushes the job may result in personal injury if the greatest of care is not exercised. Make it a habit to double check your work and to always side with caution when installing wheels. Disclaimer Page 1446 5. Insert the J 38125-557 (GM P/N 12122378) into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 6. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Connector Position Assurance Locks CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of the connector. CPAs are used in various connectors throughout the vehicle. CPAs are also used in all SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals, of the connector. Connector Repairs CONNECTOR REPAIRS Page 3728 View of connector in released position. 4. Disconnect the connector from the component. 5. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Release the rear lower half of the wiredress cover. Page 1036 Front Passenger Door Module (FPDM) Page 6689 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert terminal into the appropriate terminal holder until it hits bottom and stops. The correct terminal holder is determined by the wire size. Also ensure that the terminals wings are pointing towards the former on the tool and the release locator. 5. Insert the stripped cable into the terminal. Insulation should be visible on both sides of the terminal insulation wings. 6. Compress the handles until the ratchet automatically releases. 7. Place the terminal into the appropriate cavity and assemble the connector. Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO-PACK 100W) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W connectors. These connectors are very similar but use different terminals and have some minor physical differences also. Page 1680 Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Mass Airflow Sensor/Intake Air Temperature Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure Important: Use care when handling the mass air flow (MAF)/intake air temperature (IAT) sensor. Do not dent, puncture, or otherwise damage the honeycell located at the air inlet end of the MAF/IAT. Do not touch the sensing elements or allow anything including cleaning solvents and lubricants to come in contact with them. Use a small amount of a non-silicone based lubricant, on the air duct only, to aid in installation. 1. Disconnect the MAF/IAT sensor electrical connector. 2. Loosen the clamps at the MAF/IAT sensor and the throttle body. 3. Remove the air cleaner outlet duct bolt. 4. Remove the air cleaner outlet duct. 5. Loosen the clamp attaching the MAF/IAT sensor to the air cleaner housing. 6. Remove the MAF/IAT sensor from the air cleaner housing. Installation Procedure Important: The embossed arrow on the MAF/IAT sensor indicates the proper air flow direction. The arrow must point toward the engine. Locations Knock Sensor: Locations Engine Controls Component Views Lower Left Side of Engine - Rear 1 - G108 2 - Knock Sensor (KS) 1 - Left 3 - Engine 4 - G107 5 - Engine Harness Lower Right Side of the Engine - Rear Page 226 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Kostal Connectors KOSTAL CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 1560 All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system. Page 7338 3. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. View showing depressing of the lever lock release tab. Lower LF of the Passenger Compartment - Pedal Assembly Lower LF Of The Passenger Compartment - Pedal Assembly Page 5281 Horn - Inoperative When Pressing Horn Pad Horn Switch: All Technical Service Bulletins Horn - Inoperative When Pressing Horn Pad TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 07-08-54-001C Date: October 17, 2008 Subject: EI07279 - Horn Inoperative from Steering Wheel Horn Pad (Ground Path Repair Procedure) Models: 2006-2007 Buick Rainier 2006 Chevrolet TrailBlazer EXT 2006-2009 Chevrolet TrailBlazer 2006 GMC Envoy XL, Envoy XUV 2006-2009 GMC Envoy, Envoy Denali Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to provide field fix information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 07-08-54-001B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories). Condition Important: If the horn does NOT work from the key fob horn button, disregard this bulletin and proceed with diagnosis/repair according to SI. Some customers may comment that the horn is inoperative from the horn pad on the steering wheel. Cause The general cause of this condition is high resistance in the ground path through the steering column that energizes the horn relay. The key fob panic button uses a different ground path and is not affected. A number of locations in the circuit have been identified as sources of the high resistance. It is often difficult to pinpoint the specific location of the high resistance because the condition is usually intermittent. Attempting to discover the location can be frustrating because as circuit components are moved, the condition will often disappear. A few locations have been identified as frequent contributors to the problem. Correction Complete the following steps to diagnose and repair this condition: 1. Does the horn work by depressing the button(s) on the key fob? ^ Yes - proceed with step 2. ^ No - do not proceed with this bulletin. Diagnose and repair using information found in SI. 2. To aid in the diagnosis and to avoid disturbing others, disconnect the wiring harness from the horn assembly and insert appropriate connectors to monitor the voltage with a multi-meter or a test light. If the horn pad is currently working, rotate the steering wheel lock to lock while depressing the horn pad to determine if there are any spots in the rotation where the horn pad quits working. Caution: When performing service on or near the SIR components or the SIR wiring, the SIR system must be disabled. Refer to SIR Disabling and Enabling. Failure to observe the correct procedure could cause deployment of the SIR components, personal injury, or unnecessary SIR system Page 372 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. 4. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front of the connector. Page 4667 11. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 12. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 13. Center the high temperature SCT1 shrink tube over the DuraSeal splice sleeve. 14. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the high temperature heat shrink tubing. 15. Gradually move the heat from the center to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 16. Replace any reflective tape and clips that may have been remove during the repair. Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation REPAIRING DAMAGED WIRE INSULATION Wire Size Conversion Page 8270 2. Locate the nose piece locking tabs that are positioned on the side of the connector nose piece. The connector nose piece acts as a terminal positive assurance (TPA) and may be referred to as such. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to push in one of the locking tabs while gently pulling on the same side of the nose piece. 4. Repeat the procedure for the other locking tab and remove the nose piece. 5. Remove the wire dress cover. The following is a general procedure for wire dress cover removal. Use this procedure as a guide, some dress cover removal procedures may vary. 6. Use fingers to squeeze the 2 locking legs of the cover. Page 9057 4. Slide the dress cover forward and off of the connector. 5. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front and rear of the connector. Page 4897 Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. For connectors with a bolt in the dress cover, turn the bolt counterclockwise to remove the connector from the component. 2. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. Page 171 Page 628 Remove all rust from the ground terminal, the cylinder head and the retaining nut or bolt. Position the main engine wiring harness ground terminal and install the nut or bolt. Tighten: Tighten the retaining nut or bolt to 16 N.m (12 lb ft). Apply some type of electrical moisture sealant to protect the harness terminal from further corrosion. Disclaimer Page 8046 3. Use a small flat-bladed tool to gently pry off the dress cover by inserting the tool under the cover opposite the harness side and prying up. 4. Remove the cover. 5. Using a small flat-bladed tool, push on the side of the nose piece retainer while pushing the nose piece forward with your thumb. This will release the terminal position assurance (TPA). 6. Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) into the corresponding terminal release cavity. The release cavities are the 2 center rows of cavities on one half of the connector. Page 6585 9. The illustration shows a cutaway view of the connector to aid the technician in releasing the terminal retainer. 10. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Terminal Position Assurance Locks TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Tyco/Amp Connectors (CM 42-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (CM 42-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the connector body and pull the CPA out. The CPA is on the wire harness side of connector. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 6106 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the TPA. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the nose piece. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. Page 1750 View of typical connector. View of connector in released position. 1. Locate the assist lever at the back of the connector. Move the assist lever to the rear position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the dress cover. Page 4619 2. Locate the nose piece locking tabs that are positioned on the side of the connector nose piece. The connector nose piece acts as a terminal positive assurance (TPA) and may be referred to as such. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to push in one of the locking tabs while gently pulling on the same side of the nose piece. 4. Repeat the procedure for the other locking tab and remove the nose piece. 5. Remove the wire dress cover. The following is a general procedure for wire dress cover removal. Use this procedure as a guide, some dress cover removal procedures may vary. 6. Use fingers to squeeze the 2 locking legs of the cover. Page 7473 vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide variety of actions, including: - Wiggling the harness - Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting - Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector - Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation - Relocating a harness or wires All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. Another option is, with the component commanded ON and OFF by the scan tool, move related connectors and wiring and observe the component operation. With the engine running, move related connectors and wiring while monitoring engine operation. If harness or connector movement affects the data displayed, component/system operation, or engine operation, inspect and repair the harness/connections as necessary. You may need to load the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these cases you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide good results as well. There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions, along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the circuit to these kinds of conditions. SALT WATER SPRAY Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture. Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5 percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously. HIGH TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070. Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault condition. The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis. This option does not allow for the same control, however. LOW TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect. If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to -18°C (0°F) from one end and +71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized cooling needs. Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or components in an effort to duplicate the concern. DUPLICATING FAILURE CONDITIONS - If none of the previous tests are successful, attempt to duplicate and/or capture the failure conditions. Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, where applicable, contains the conditions that were present when the DTC set. 1. Review and record Freeze Frame/Failure Records data. 2. Clear the DTCs using the scan tool. 3. Turn the key to OFF and wait 15 seconds. 4. Operate the vehicle under the same conditions that were noted in Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, as closely as possible. The vehicle must also be operating within the Conditions for Running the DTC. Refer to Conditions for Running the DTC in the supporting text if a DTC is being diagnosed. 5. Monitor DTC Status for the DTC being tested. The scan tool will indicate Ran, when the enabling conditions have been satisfied long enough for the DTC to run. The scan tool will also indicate whether the DTC passed or failed. - An alternate method is to drive the vehicle with the DMM connected to a suspected circuit. An abnormal reading on the DMM when the concern occurs, may help you locate the concern. Measuring Frequency Page 8625 For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 7172 Connector Anatomy Connector Repairs contains a list of all connector repairs. The connector repairs are listed by the connector manufacturer and then by connector type. If the technician cannot identify the manufacturer of the connector, refer to Identifying Connectors below. Knowing the connector manufacturer will assist in finding the correct connector repair from the following list: - Connector Position Assurance Locks - Terminal Position Assurance Locks - Bosch Connectors (0.64) Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) Bosch Connectors (BSK) Bosch Connectors (ECM) - Delphi Connectors (Micro.64) Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) Delphi Connectors (12-Way) - Tyco/AMP Connectors (CM 42-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) Tyco/AMP Connectors (025 Cap) Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) - Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) - Repairing Connector Terminals IDENTIFYING CONNECTORS Knowing the connector manufacturer is helpful when trying to locating the correct connector repair procedure. There are many different connector designs used on GM vehicles and it is sometimes difficult to identify the connector manufacturer. The information in this document should help with the identification of connector manufactures. The following connector manufacturers make most of the connectors found in GM vehicles: AFL/EPC (Alcoa Fujikura Ltd./Engineered Plastics Components) - Bosch - Delphi - FCI (Framatome Connectors International) - JAE (Japan Aviation Electronics) - JST (Japan Solderless Terminals) Page 7102 US English/Metric Conversion US English/Metric Conversion Page 7471 Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Page 215 TERMINAL REMOVAL Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors. 1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA) device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1). 3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 4. Gently pull the cable and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector. 5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal, refer to Terminal Repair. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3. Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector. REINSTALLING TERMINAL 1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly, refer to Wiring Repairs. 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3. Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) DELPHI CONNECTORS (WEATHER PACK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 7851 Oxygen Sensor: Service Precautions Excessive Force and Oxygen Sensor Notice Excessive Force and Oxygen Sensor Notice Notice: The oxygen sensor may be difficult to remove when the engine temperature is below 48°C (120°F). Excessive force may damage threads in the exhaust manifold or the exhaust pipe. Page 8456 Open the harness by removing any tape. 2. Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. 3. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 4. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent american wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 5. Slide a section of high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing down the length of wire to be spliced. Ensure that the shrink tubing will not interfere with the splice procedure. 6. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 7. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. 8. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 9. Insert the wire into the DuraSeal splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 10. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Page 7681 Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size. REPAIRING A FUSIBLE LINK IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient overload protection. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. Flat Wire Repairs FLAT WIRE REPAIRS NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced. GMLAN Wiring Repairs GMLAN WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The GM Local Area Network (GMLAN) System requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working on GMLAN connectors and terminals. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items in order to repair the GMLAN wiring: Dura Seal splice sleeves - A wire stripping tool - J 38125-8 Crimping Tool (GM P/N 12085115) - J 38125-5 Ultra Torch Special Tool (GM P/N 12085116) The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. - A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors GMLAN REPAIRS IMPORTANT: When making a repair to any GMLAN network, the original wire length after the repair must be the same length as before the repair. If the network is a twisted pair, the twist must be maintained after the repair is completed. GMLAN has 2 types of networks, low speed and high speed. Low speed GMLAN has a single wire and works at slow speeds. High speed GMLAN has 2 wires in a twisted pair and works at higher speeds. For more information on GMLAN, refer to Data Link Communications Description and Operation. GMLAN CONNECTOR TERMINAL REPAIR IMPORTANT: A service terminal can be used to replace damaged connector terminals for both high speed and low speed GMLAN systems. When making a connector terminal repair on a GMLAN high speed system with twisted pair wires, do not untwist the wires more than necessary to make the repair. The terminals in the GMLAN system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are available in the J-38125. If the individual terminals are damaged on any GMLAN connection, use the appropriate connector repair procedure in order to repair the terminal. GMLAN WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Service and Repair Coolant Reservoir: Service and Repair Coolant Recovery Reservoir Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Remove the air cleaner assembly. Refer to Air Cleaner Assembly Replacement for the 4.2L engine or Air Cleaner Assembly Replacement for the 5.3L engine, or Air Cleaner Assembly Replacement for the 6.0L engine. 2. Remove the accumulator. Refer to Accumulator Replacement. 3. Remove the coolant hoses from the coolant recovery reservoir and plug the hoses and the coolant recovery reservoir outlets with suitable plugs (2). 4. Remove the nut and bolt securing the coolant recovery reservoir. 5. Remove the coolant recovery reservoir. Installation Procedure 1. Install the coolant recovery reservoir. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Install the coolant recovery reservoir bolt. Tighten the bolt to 12 N.m (106 lb in). 3. Install the coolant recovery reservoir nut. Tighten the nut to 10 N.m (89 lb in). 4. Install the coolant hose to the coolant recovery reservoir (2). 5. Install the accumulator. Refer to Accumulator Replacement. 6. Install the air cleaner assembly. Refer to Air Cleaner Assembly Replacement for the 4.2L engine or Air Cleaner Assembly Replacement for the 5.3L engine, or Air Cleaner Assembly Replacement for the 6.0L engine. Page 1765 4. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the rear of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. 5. Once the locking tabs are unlocked, slide the inner connector out of the rear of the connector housing. Page 6555 4. Once the front 2 locks are unlocked, lift the front of the dress cover and pull it forward. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the small slot on the TPA and pushing down until the TPA releases. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to angle or rock the J 38125-21 tool when inserting it into the connector or the tool may break. Insert the J 38125-21 (GM P/N 15381651-2) tool into the round canal between the terminals cavities at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to repair Micro 64 connector terminals. The Micro 64 connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-64 (M jaw) was developed to crimp Micro 64 terminals. The J 38125-64 crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. The J 38125-64 crimping tool is also designed to crimp both the wire and the insulation at the same time. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro 64 terminals. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. 1. Cut the wire as close to the damaged terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. Page 830 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (BSK) BOSCH CONNECTORS (BSK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 3. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 4. Insert the J 38125-561 tool into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 5. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is Page 6605 Open the harness by removing any tape. 2. Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. 3. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 4. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent american wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 5. Slide a section of high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing down the length of wire to be spliced. Ensure that the shrink tubing will not interfere with the splice procedure. 6. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 7. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. 8. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 9. Insert the wire into the DuraSeal splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 10. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Page 6142 If a wire is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm, etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except coaxial. - Do not use the DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent American wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 3768 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the rear TPA from the connector. 7. IMPORTANT: The front TPA cannot be removed from the connector. Only move it to the release point. Use a small flat-blade tool to move the front TPA to the release position. 8. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 9. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Molex Connectors Page 4508 The first connector design of the Micro-Pack 100W (1) has a white connector interface that holds the terminals. The second design of the Micro-Pack 100W (2) has a gray interface to hold the terminals. Also, the first design has terminal cavities that are further apart (3 mm centerline) and offset from the other row of terminal cavities in the connector. The second design has terminals cavities that are closer together (2.54 mm centerline) and aligned vertically. One other way to identify the second design is the thin strip of material that runs along the outside of the cavities. IMPORTANT: There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W terminals which are very similar. Ensure that you have the correct terminal before crimping the new terminal to the wire. The first design connector uses the longer terminal (1) that has a raised area in front of the recess in the terminal. The second design connector uses the shorter terminal without the raised area. Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro-Pack 100W connectors. Some Micro-Pack 100W connector disassembly procedures will vary. Use this procedure as a guide. 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 5548 - In some cases Delphi will actually be printed on the connector. If Delphi is not printed on the connector, look for PED. In both cases there is no specific orientation for Delphi or PED and they can appear anywhere on the connector. - FCI connectors may have the FCI logo on their connectors. The logo is the letters FCI with an "A" above it. - JAE connector have JAE in small letters on their connectors. Page 2437 View of connector in released position. 4. Disconnect the connector from the component. 5. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Release the rear lower half of the wiredress cover. Page 7684 The engine harness may be repaired using the J-38125. High Temperature Wiring Repairs HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperatures, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time may use materials i.e. wires, connectors, and shielding that has a higher heat rating than typical wiring. When making a repair in a high temperature area observe the following: Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature to replace any damaged wire. - Replace any heat shielding that is removed. - Cover any DuraSeal splice sleeves with SCT1 shrink tubing (available in the J-38125 Terminal Repair kit). - After making a wiring repair, ensure that the location of the wiring is not moved closer to the heat source. IDENTIFYING HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperature, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time need special considerations when making wiring repairs. Areas that may be exposed to higher temperatures can be identified by heat resistant materials that are being used in those areas. These materials may include heat reflective tape, moon tape, and high temperature shrink tubing. Also conduit and other protective coverings may be used. Because conduit or similar coverings are used throughout the vehicle regardless of the temperature, it may be necessary for the technician to determine if an area is exposed to excessive heat before making a wiring repair. Obvious areas of consideration would be any area located near the exhaust manifolds, catalytic converter, and exhaust pipes. The J-38125 contains much of the material you will need to perform repairs on areas exposed to high heat. The kit contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves to crimp and seal connections - High temperature SCT1 shrink tubing to protect the splice sleeves - A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct crimp tool to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools to remove the terminals from the connectors The J-38125 does not contain wire that is suitable to high temperature exposure. Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature of the same or larger gage size as the original wire when repair damage wire. Also replace any reflective tape that you remove during the repair. HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature rating of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125 and then encapsulate the splice sleeve using the high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the order listed. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip keeping all of the wire strands intact. Page 8366 Specifications Fuel Pressure: Specifications Fuel Pressure (Key ON, Engine OFF).................................................................................................. ..............................................345-414 kPa (50-60 psi) Page 688 - A control module from another vehicle is installed. - Revised software/calibration files have been released for this vehicle. - IMPORTANT: DO NOT re-program the control module with the SAME software/calibration files that are already present in the control module. This is not an effective repair for any type of concern. Verify that the control module contains the correct software/calibration. If incorrect programming is found, reprogram the control module with the most current software/calibration. Refer to Control Module References for replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Testing for Short to Ground TESTING FOR SHORT TO GROUND NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 4. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit. With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is a short to ground in the circuit. Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2. Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). - When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. - If the DMM does not display voltage 4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is shorted. Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A DIGITAL MULTIMETER NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the powertrain control module (PCM), should only be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200 Digital Multimeter (DMM). The J 39200 instruction manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminage even though voltage is present. The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity. IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading. Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the measurement. Page 7490 IMPORTANT: Ensure that the dress cover and connector body are both in the released position before reassembling. Failure to do so may cause damage to the connector and component. Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (0.64) BOSCH CONNECTORS (0.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While pressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock until the lever is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Pull the rubber boot that covers the wires back to expose the end of the connector dress cover. 4. Place the connector locking lever in the center of the connector. 5. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs that are on the wire end of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover and connector body and pry up. Page 4255 Fuel Pressure: Vehicle Damage Warnings Fuel Pressure Notice Notice: Do not allow the fuel pressure to exceed the specified value because damage to the fuel pressure regulator or the fuel pressure gage may result. Page 5675 View of connector in released position. 4. Disconnect the connector from the component. 5. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Release the rear lower half of the wiredress cover. Page 2200 Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Page 6649 Page 6798 15. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground wire terminal. 16. Install the electrical ground wire terminal to the rivet stud. 17. Select a M6 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 18. Install the M6 conductive nut to the rivet stud and: Tighten Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb in). 19. Verify proper system operation. M6 Weld Nut Caution Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground repair. 1. If the M6 weld nut at the electrical ground location is damaged or stripped, a M7 conductive self-threading bolt may be used to secure the ground wire terminal. 2. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the surface surrounding the weld nut and allow to dry. 3. Remove any loose metal particles from the damaged or stripped weld nut with a stiff brush. 4. Select a M7 conductive self-threading bolt. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin 5. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M7 conductive self-threading bolt. Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase. 6. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground wire terminal. 7. Install the electrical ground wire terminal to the M7 conductive self-threading bolt. 8. Install the M7 conductive self-threading bolt and: Tighten Tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb in). 9. Verify proper system operation. M6 Weld Nut Alternative Repair Caution Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground repair. 1. If the electrical ground location is accessible from both sides of the panel, a M6 conductive bolt and a M6 conductive nut may be used to secure the electrical ground wire terminal. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 2. Select a location adjacent the damaged M6 weld nut having 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance behind the panel surface and 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance surrounding the new electrical ground site. 3. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the surface surrounding the ground location and allow to dry. Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled. 4. Drill a 8.5 mm (0.33 in) diameter hole through the panel. 5. Remove paint and primer from the area surrounding the 8.5 mm (0.33 in) hole until bare metal is visible. 6. Select a M6 conductive bolt. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 7. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M6 conductive bolt. Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase. 8. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground wire terminal. 9. Install the electrical ground wire terminal and the M6 conductive bolt to the ground location. 10. Select a M6 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 11. Install the M6 conductive nut to the bolt and: Page 6716 5. Once the nose piece retainers are relaxed, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should raise slightly. 6. On the opposite side of the nose piece, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should release completely. If the nose piece does not come off, repeat the procedure on the opposite side. Page 1448 - Kostel - Molex - Sumitomo - Tyco/AMP - Yazaki Identifying the manufacturer of a connector is often difficult. When trying to determine the manufacturer of a connector, look for specific identifying marks that are unique to that connector supplier. Most of these identify marks are hard to find or see. Check the connector carefully and refer to the information below for pictures and descriptions of connector identification markings. - Most of AFLs connectors have EPC on their connector body. Some of the smaller connectors will not have any markings on them. - In some cases Bosch will actually be printed on the connector. If Bosch does not appear on the connector, look for the Bosch logo. The Bosch logo is a circle with a blunted arrow inside. This logo can appear anywhere on the connector and is often very small. Locations Battery Control Module: Locations Starting and Charging Component Views Rear of Battery - 5.3L/6.0L 1 - Positive Battery Terminal 2 - Regulated Voltage Control Module 3 - Battery 4 - Negative Battery Terminal Page 6471 7. The illustration above identifies the entry canal where the terminal release tool will be inserted, and the terminal cavity. - Terminal (1) - Entry Canal (2) 8. Insert the J-38125-553 (15315247) tool into the entry canal and pry up on the terminal retainer. The terminal retainer is a small plastic piece on the top of the terminal. The terminal retainer must be held up while the terminal is pulled out of the connector. Page 6552 View of a typical Micro 64 connector. Depress the lock and pull the lever over and past the lock. Page 6873 Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Page 5013 Thermostat: Service and Repair Thermostat Replacement (5.3L and 6.0L Engines) Removal Procedure Important: The thermostat is not serviceable separately. The water pump inlet and thermostat must be replaced as an assembly. 1. Remove the radiator outlet hose. Refer to Radiator Outlet Hose Replacement (LH6, LS2) Radiator Outlet Hose Replacement (LL8). 2. Remove the water pump inlet bolts. 3. Remove the water pump inlet and thermostat from the water pump. Installation Procedure 1. Install the thermostat and thermostat housing to the water pump. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Install the thermostat housing bolts. Tighten the bolts to 15 N.m (11 lb ft). 3. Install the radiator outlet hose. Refer to Radiator Outlet Hose Replacement (LH6, LS2) Radiator Outlet Hose Replacement (LL8). Page 5128 2. Connect the MDI to the Data Link Connector (DLC) of the vehicle. Note Use the USB port to make the following MDI connection: 3. Connect the MDI to a PC or laptop that has been downloaded with the GDS application from TIS2WEB. Note At least one Diagnostic Package must be installed on the PC to perform diagnostics. If GDS was just installed, select: Add New Diagnostic Package and then select: a Diagnostic Package to download. 4. Click: On the GDS icon on the PC. 5. The Login Page will appear. 6. Select: A User. 7. The ID Screen will appear. 8. Select: The serial number of the MDI being used. 9. Select: Connect. 10. Verify that the system status is ready by observing for a flashing PC light icon on the MDI. 11. Select: Make, Model and Model Year, in order to build the vehicle. 12. Click: Upload VIN, to allow the VIN to be reported to the PC. 13. At: The Verification step, turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. 14. Select: Next Action. 15. The Home Page will appear. 16. Select: Next. 17. The Diagnostic Screen will appear. Note Due to vehicle build, software and RPO variations, GDS may ask for additional information in Step 18. 18. Select: Engine ID, if prompted. 19. Select: Module Diagnostics. 20. Select: ECM. 21. Select: ID Information. 22. The Diagnostics page will appear. Typical View of GDS Calibration History Screen Note GDS is capable of displaying up to 10 Calibration History events. 23. Select: Calibration History from the drop down menu in order to display the following items on the screen: - Calibration History Buffer - Number of Calibration History Events Stored - Calibration Part Number History - Calibration Verification Number History 24. Select: Screenshot. 25. Name and save the file in an appropriate folder. 26. Select : Print, and retain a copy of the screenshot with the repair order. Page 1905 6. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by pressing on the tang. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (SENSOR) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) tool into the cavity on the lower right hand face of the connector until the terminal release tang access panel slides over. Page 5798 Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Page 5317 Depress the locks that are located on both sides of the wiredress cover and pull the lever over and past the locks. View of the connector when released from the component. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the front of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool push down on one of the locking tabs and pull the cover up until the dress cover releases. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. Page 2394 11. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 12. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 13. Center the high temperature SCT1 shrink tube over the DuraSeal splice sleeve. 14. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the high temperature heat shrink tubing. 15. Gradually move the heat from the center to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 16. Replace any reflective tape and clips that may have been remove during the repair. Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation REPAIRING DAMAGED WIRE INSULATION Wire Size Conversion Page 5329 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the TPA. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the nose piece. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. Page 2624 6. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by pressing on the tang. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (SENSOR) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) tool into the cavity on the lower right hand face of the connector until the terminal release tang access panel slides over. Page 6933 5. Once the nose piece retainers are relaxed, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should raise slightly. 6. On the opposite side of the nose piece, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should release completely. If the nose piece does not come off, repeat the procedure on the opposite side. Page 1585 5. Insert the J 38125-557 (GM P/N 12122378) into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 6. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Connector Position Assurance Locks CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of the connector. CPAs are used in various connectors throughout the vehicle. CPAs are also used in all SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals, of the connector. Connector Repairs CONNECTOR REPAIRS Page 184 It is very important to use the correct test adapter when testing for proper terminal contact of fuses and relays in a bussed electrical center (BEC). Use J-35616-35 to test for proper terminal contact. Failure to use J-35616-35 can result in improper diagnosis of the BEC. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Separate the connector halves. 2. Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body. 3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J-38125 , test that the retention force is significantly different between a good terminal and a suspect terminal. Replace the female terminal in question. FLAT WIRE (DOCK AND LOCK) CONNECTORS There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock) connectors on the harness side or the component side. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Remove the component in question. 2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side of the connector as oil from your skin may be a source of contamination as well. 3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other imperfections that could cause poor terminal contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are uniform and free of damage or deformation. 4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the on the flat wire harness connector in order to test the circuit in question. CONTROL MODULE/COMPONENT VOLTAGE AND GROUNDS Poor voltage or ground connections can cause widely varying symptoms. Test all control module voltage supply circuits. Many vehicles have multiple circuits supplying voltage to a control module. Other components in the system may have separate voltage supply circuits that may also need to be tested. Inspect connections at the module/component connectors, fuses, and any intermediate connections between the voltage source and the module/component. A test lamp or a DMM may indicate that voltage is present, but neither tests the ability of the circuit to carry sufficient current. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Power Distribution Schematics. - Test all control module ground and system ground circuits. The control module may have multiple ground circuits. Other components in the system may have separate grounds that may also need to be tested. Inspect grounds for clean and tight connections at the grounding point. Inspect the connections at the component and in splice packs, where applicable. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Ground Distribution Schematics. TEMPERATURE SENSITIVITY - An intermittent condition may occur when a component/connection reaches normal operating temperature. The condition may occur only when the component/connection is cold, or only when the component/connection is hot. - Freeze Frame, Failure Records, Snapshot, or Vehicle Data Recorder data may help with this type of intermittent condition, where applicable. - If the intermittent is related to heat, review the data for a relationship with the following: High ambient temperatures - Underhood/engine generated heat - Circuit generated heat due to a poor connection, or high electrical load - Higher than normal load conditions, towing, etc. - If the intermittent is related to cold, review the data for the following: Low ambient temperatures-In extremely low temperatures, ice may form in a connection or component. Inspect for water intrusion. - The condition only occurs on a cold start. - The condition goes away when the vehicle warms up. - Information from the customer may help to determine if the trouble follows a pattern that is temperature related. - If temperature is suspected of causing an intermittent fault condition, attempt to duplicate the condition. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required. ELECTROMAGNETIC INTERFERENCE (EMI) AND ELECTRICAL NOISE Some electrical components/circuits are sensitive to electromagnetic interference (EMI) or other types of electrical noise. Inspect for the following conditions: A misrouted harness that is too close to high voltage/high current devices such as secondary ignition components, motors, generator etc-These components may induce electrical noise on a circuit that could interfere with normal circuit operation. - Electrical system interference caused by a malfunctioning relay, or a control module driven solenoid or switch-These conditions can cause a sharp electrical surge. Normally, the condition will occur when the malfunctioning component is operating. - Improper installation of non-factory or aftermarket add on accessories such as lights, 2-way radios, amplifiers, electric motors, remote starters, alarm systems, cell phones, etc-These accessories may lead to interference while in use, but do not fail when the accessories are not in use. - Test for an open diode across the A/C compressor clutch and for other open diodes. Some relays may contain a clamping diode. - The generator may be allowing AC noise into the electrical system. INCORRECT CONTROL MODULE - There are only a few situations where reprogramming a control module is appropriate: A new service control module is installed. Page 551 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the DuraSeal splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of a connector. CPAs are used in all SIR System connectors and also in some connectors of other systems. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals of a connection. TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE CLIPS IMPORTANT: When making a splice in an area that may be exposed to moisture use a crimp and seal splice sleeve instead of a Splice Clip. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. Page 7279 2. Connect the MDI to the Data Link Connector (DLC) of the vehicle. Note Use the USB port to make the following MDI connection: 3. Connect the MDI to a PC or laptop that has been downloaded with the GDS application from TIS2WEB. Note At least one Diagnostic Package must be installed on the PC to perform diagnostics. If GDS was just installed, select: Add New Diagnostic Package and then select: a Diagnostic Package to download. 4. Click: On the GDS icon on the PC. 5. The Login Page will appear. 6. Select: A User. 7. The ID Screen will appear. 8. Select: The serial number of the MDI being used. 9. Select: Connect. 10. Verify that the system status is ready by observing for a flashing PC light icon on the MDI. 11. Select: Make, Model and Model Year, in order to build the vehicle. 12. Click: Upload VIN, to allow the VIN to be reported to the PC. 13. At: The Verification step, turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. 14. Select: Next Action. 15. The Home Page will appear. 16. Select: Next. 17. The Diagnostic Screen will appear. Note Due to vehicle build, software and RPO variations, GDS may ask for additional information in Step 18. 18. Select: Engine ID, if prompted. 19. Select: Module Diagnostics. 20. Select: ECM. 21. Select: ID Information. 22. The Diagnostics page will appear. Typical View of GDS Calibration History Screen Note GDS is capable of displaying up to 10 Calibration History events. 23. Select: Calibration History from the drop down menu in order to display the following items on the screen: - Calibration History Buffer - Number of Calibration History Events Stored - Calibration Part Number History - Calibration Verification Number History 24. Select: Screenshot. 25. Name and save the file in an appropriate folder. 26. Select : Print, and retain a copy of the screenshot with the repair order. Page 6392 Page 4559 If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the DuraSeal splice sleeves. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: - Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. - Do not use the crimp and DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 to crimp DuraSeal splice sleeve. In order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 816 Checking Aftermarket Accessories CHECKING AFTERMARKET ACCESSORIES Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits: - CAUTION: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol. - NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice. OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol. Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the cause of the problems. Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include: Power feeds connected to points other than the battery - Antenna location - Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring - Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line - Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories. Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions INDUCING INTERMITTENT FAULT CONDITIONS TOOLS REQUIRED J 25070 Heat Gun Many intermittent open or shorted circuits are affected by harness/connector movement that is caused by vibration, engine torque, bumps/rough pavement, etc. In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness if the malfunction appears to be Page 4771 Page 4568 Page 2178 5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape. Seat Belt Schematic Icons Seat Belt Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons Page 5377 5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape. Seat Belt Schematic Icons Seat Belt Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons Page 7076 4. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the rear of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. 5. Once the locking tabs are unlocked, slide the inner connector out of the rear of the connector housing. Page 8737 11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the solder equipment. 12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. 13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to cover the first piece of tape. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE SLEEVES TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit IMPORTANT: Use only dura seal splice sleeves. Other splice sleeves may not protect the splice from moisture or provide a good electrical connection. Use duraseal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. Use duraseal splice sleeves where there is special requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire using duraseal splice sleeves. Page 3047 Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair Evaporator Tube Replacement Evaporator Tube Replacement Tools Required * J26549-E Orifice Tube Remover * J39400-A Halogen Leak Detector Removal Procedure 1. Recover the refrigerant. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 2. Loosen the evaporator tube (5) from the evaporator. 3. Loosen the auxiliary evaporator tube (7) from the auxiliary piping. 4. Remove the evaporator tube nut from the condenser. 5. Remove the nuts (1, 2) retaining the evaporator tube to the fender. 6. Remove the washer solvent container. 7. Remove the coolant recovery tank. 8. Remove the evaporator tube using J26549-E. 9. Remove the O-ring seal and discard. Installation Procedure 1. Install the new O-ring seal. 2. Install the evaporator tube. Page 9053 2. Locate the two indents of the terminal position assurance (TPA) located on the bottom of the connector body. Page 3390 The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors. 1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position. 4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool J 38125-10A (GM P/N 12014012-1) into the front (mating end) of the connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal through the back of the connector (2). IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector. 6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. 7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily. 10. Perform system check. Delphi Connectors (12 Way) DELPHI CONNECTORS (12-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. Page 8460 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the DuraSeal splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of a connector. CPAs are used in all SIR System connectors and also in some connectors of other systems. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals of a connection. TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE CLIPS IMPORTANT: When making a splice in an area that may be exposed to moisture use a crimp and seal splice sleeve instead of a Splice Clip. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. Page 8443 2. Use a small flat-bladed tool to release the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting the tool in the small recess on the side of the connector and pushing up until the TPA releases from the connector body. The TPA should raise just slightly. Do not try to remove the TPA. IMPORTANT: The TPA on this connector cannot be removed unless the terminals are removed first. The TPA will come out of the connector body, but only slightly. When the TPA is slightly raised the terminals can be removed. Using excessive force to remove the TPA with the terminals still in the connector will damage the connector. 3. Repeat the process for the other side of the connector. 4. Ensure that the TPA is in the proper position to remove the terminals. Page 2629 View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. View of the release tool being used for the smaller terminals. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (2-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 1330 6. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs located on the opposite side of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover at the connector end and pry up. 7. Remove the dress cover. 8. Cut the tie wrap on the wire bundle. 9. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting a small flat-bladed tool into the small slot in the end of the slider and pushing on the TPA until it comes out of the connector. When the TPA exits the opposite side of the connector, gasp the TPA and pull it completely out of the connector. 10. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 7630 - Most Molex connectors will have the Molex logo on the dresscover of the connector. In some cases the connectors may have MX followed by another letter. The third letter indicates where the connector was made. A connector with MXD is a Molex connector made in Detroit. Sumitomo has a unique symbol on their connector and possibly a part number. The symbol is similar to that of a diamond lying on its side, similar to that shown. The logo could appear anywhere but the most common place is at the wire side of the housing. Tyco/AMP has many different and unique connector designs. Some may or may not have identifiable marks on them. Page 1965 Checking Aftermarket Accessories CHECKING AFTERMARKET ACCESSORIES Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits: - CAUTION: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol. - NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice. OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol. Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the cause of the problems. Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include: Power feeds connected to points other than the battery - Antenna location - Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring - Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line - Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories. Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions INDUCING INTERMITTENT FAULT CONDITIONS TOOLS REQUIRED J 25070 Heat Gun Many intermittent open or shorted circuits are affected by harness/connector movement that is caused by vibration, engine torque, bumps/rough pavement, etc. In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness if the malfunction appears to be Page 8648 Page 5540 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. 4. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front of the connector. Page 4599 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (BSK) BOSCH CONNECTORS (BSK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 3. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 4. Insert the J 38125-561 tool into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 5. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is Page 669 Page 1716 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. 4. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front of the connector. Page 7463 Page 7757 If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200 DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J 39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected. IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J 39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and maximum (MAX) values measured. 1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of a suspected circuit to the other. 2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J 39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep). IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value in order to record the full change. 5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling the connections or the wiring, test driving, or performing other operations. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions. 6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9. Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist. Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections TESTING FOR INTERMITTENT CONDITIONS AND POOR CONNECTIONS TOOLS REQUIRED - J 35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit - J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit When the condition is not currently present, but is indicated in DTC history, the cause may be intermittent. An intermittent may also be the cause when there is a customer complaint, but the symptom cannot be duplicated. Refer to the Symptom Table of the system that is suspect of causing the condition before trying to locate an intermittent condition. Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the following items: Wiring broken inside the insulation - Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector - Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself, and corrosion in the wire to terminal contact area, etc. - Pierced or damaged insulation can allow moisture to enter the wiring causing corrosion. The conductor can corrode inside the insulation, with little visible evidence. Look for swollen and stiff sections of wire in the suspect circuits. - Wiring which has been pinched, cut, or its insulation rubbed through may cause an intermittent open or short as the bare area touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle. - Wiring that comes in contact with hot or exhaust components - Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required, in order to verify the customer concern. - Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. - Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis and Vehicle Data Recorder operation. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any inline connectors before replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation. Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination, usually in the underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit. Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper adapter. Always use the J 35616 when probing connectors. Other causes of terminal deformation are improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT IN BUSSED ELECTRICAL CENTERS (BEC) Page 770 5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape. Seat Belt Schematic Icons Seat Belt Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons Page 6003 4. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the rear of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. 5. Once the locking tabs are unlocked, slide the inner connector out of the rear of the connector housing. Page 1861 Connector Anatomy Connector Repairs contains a list of all connector repairs. The connector repairs are listed by the connector manufacturer and then by connector type. If the technician cannot identify the manufacturer of the connector, refer to Identifying Connectors below. Knowing the connector manufacturer will assist in finding the correct connector repair from the following list: - Connector Position Assurance Locks - Terminal Position Assurance Locks - Bosch Connectors (0.64) Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) Bosch Connectors (BSK) Bosch Connectors (ECM) - Delphi Connectors (Micro.64) Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) Delphi Connectors (12-Way) - Tyco/AMP Connectors (CM 42-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) Tyco/AMP Connectors (025 Cap) Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) - Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) - Repairing Connector Terminals IDENTIFYING CONNECTORS Knowing the connector manufacturer is helpful when trying to locating the correct connector repair procedure. There are many different connector designs used on GM vehicles and it is sometimes difficult to identify the connector manufacturer. The information in this document should help with the identification of connector manufactures. The following connector manufacturers make most of the connectors found in GM vehicles: AFL/EPC (Alcoa Fujikura Ltd./Engineered Plastics Components) - Bosch - Delphi - FCI (Framatome Connectors International) - JAE (Japan Aviation Electronics) - JST (Japan Solderless Terminals) Page 5645 Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Service and Repair Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure Notice: Use care when handling the coolant sensor. Damage to the coolant sensor will affect the operation of the fuel control system. 1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Raise and suitably support the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 3. Drain the cooling system below the level of the ECT sensor. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System (LL8) Draining and Filling Cooling System (LH6, LS2). 4. Lower the vehicle. 5. Disconnect the engine coolant temperature (ECT) sensor electrical connector (1). 6. Remove the ECT sensor. Installation Procedure Notice: Replacement components must be the correct part number for the application. Components requiring the use of the thread locking compound, lubricants, corrosion inhibitors, or sealants are identified in the service procedure. Some replacement components may come with these coatings already applied. Do not use these coatings on components unless specified. These coatings can affect the final torque, which may affect the operation of the component. Use the correct torque specification when installing components in order to avoid damage. Notice: Use care when handling the coolant sensor. Damage to the coolant sensor will affect the operation of the fuel control system. 1. Coat the ECT sensor threads with sealer GM P/N 12346004 (Canadian P/N 10953480), or equivalent. Page 2450 - JST connectors have JST in small letters on their connectors, similar to that above. The location of the logo will vary with the connector size and style. - Kostel has an "LK" with a circle around it. These connector are usually used as a transmissions connection and are currently use on some Cadillac vehicles. Page 3730 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (BSK) BOSCH CONNECTORS (BSK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 3. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 4. Insert the J 38125-561 tool into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 5. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is Page 169 Page 529 7. Pressing the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool in the release cavity of the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and crimper in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (DOOR MODULE) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Side view of connector. View of top of connector. 1. Locate the assist lever and lock on the top of the connector. Page 4317 Tighten the nut to 10 N.m (89 lb in). 4. Install the hose to the throttle body. 5. Using J 38185, position the throttle body hose clamp at the throttle body. 6. Install the inlet and outlet hoses/pipes to the water pump. 7. Using J 38185, position the auxiliary heater inlet and outlet hose/pipe clamps at the water pump. 8. Install the outlet hose to the water pump. 9. Using J 38185, position the outlet hose clamp at the water pump. 10. Install the inlet hose to the water pump. 11. Using J 38185, position the inlet hose clamp at the water pump. 12. Install the cooing fan and shroud. Refer to Cooling Fan and Shroud Replacement. 13. Install the accessory drive belt tensioner. Refer to Drive Belt Tensioner Replacement Accessory for the 5.3L engine or Drive Belt Tensioner Replacement - Accessory for the 6.0L engine. Page 6466 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry one side of the nose piece up to the pre-stage position. When the nose piece is in the pre-staged position, the nose piece will be raised above the connector body the length of the step in the nose piece. 7. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry the other side of the piece to the pre-stage position. If the nose piece is higher than the first step in the nose piece, gently push down on the nose piece until it meets with resistance from the connector body, you should feel the nose piece click into position. Page 7527 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry one side of the nose piece up to the pre-stage position. When the nose piece is in the pre-staged position, the nose piece will be raised above the connector body the length of the step in the nose piece. 7. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry the other side of the piece to the pre-stage position. If the nose piece is higher than the first step in the nose piece, gently push down on the nose piece until it meets with resistance from the connector body, you should feel the nose piece click into position. Page 6707 View of typical connector. View of connector in released position. 1. Locate the assist lever at the back of the connector. Move the assist lever to the rear position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the dress cover. Page 7468 All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system. Page 7593 Page 442 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link). - The wire insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. 5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold them between thumb and forefinger. 7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place. - Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction. - Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip. 8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool closes.Ensure that no strands of wire are cut. 10. Crimp the splice on each end (2). Page 5802 IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals. Front probe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the connector. IMPORTANT: When probing female 0.64 terminals, it is important to use the correct adapter. There have been some revisions to the test adapter for 0.64 terminals. The proper adapter for 0.64 terminals is the J 35616-64B which has a gold terminal and a black wire between the base and tip. Failure to use the proper test adapter may result in damage to the terminal being tested and improper diagnosis. NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 04-06-04-054B Date: November 18, 2010 Subject: Info - Non-GM Parts and Accessories (Aftermarket) Models: 2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years and update to the new U.S. Fixed Operation Manager (FOM) and Canada Warranty Manager (WM) names. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 04-06-04-054A (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). The recent rise and expansion of companies selling non-GM parts and accessories has made it necessary to issue this reminder to dealers regarding GM's policy on the use and installation of these aftermarket components. When a dealer is performing a repair under the New Vehicle Limited Warranty, they are required to use only genuine GM or GM-approved parts and accessories. This applies to all warranty repairs, special policy repairs or any repairs paid for by GM. Parts and accessories advertised as being "the same" as parts manufactured by GM, but not sold through GM, do not qualify for use in warranty repairs, special policy repairs or any repairs paid for by GM. During a warranty repair, if a GM original equipment part is not available through GM Customer Care and Aftersales (GM CC&A;), ACDelco(R) distributors, other GM dealers or approved sources, the dealer is to obtain comparable, non-GM parts and clearly indicate, in detail, on the repair order the circumstances surrounding why non-GM parts were used. The dealer must give customers written notice, prior to the sale or service, that such parts or accessories are not marketed or warranted by General Motors. It should also be noted that dealers modifying new vehicles and installing equipment, parts and accessories obtained from sources not authorized by GM are responsible for complying with the National Traffic and Motor Vehicle Safety Act. Certain non-approved parts or assemblies, installed by the dealer or its agent not authorized by GM, may result in a change to the vehicle's design characteristics and may affect the vehicle's ability to conform to federal law. Dealers must fully understand that non-GM approved parts may not have been validated, tested or certified for use. This puts the dealer at risk for potential liability in the event of a part or vehicle failure. If a GM part failure occurs as the result of the installation or use of a non-GM approved part, the warranty will not be honored. A good example of non-authorized modification of vehicles is the result of an ever increasing supply of aftermarket devices available to the customer, which claim to increase the horsepower and torque of the Duramax(TM) Diesel Engines. These include the addition of, but are not limited to one or more of the following modifications: - Propane injection - Nitrous oxide injection - Additional modules (black boxes) that connect to the vehicle wiring systems - Revised engine calibrations downloaded for the engine control module - Calibration modules which connect to the vehicle diagnostic connector - Modification to the engine turbocharger waste gate Although the installation of these devices, or modification of vehicle components, can increase engine horsepower and torque, they may also negatively affect the engine emissions, reliability and/or durability. In addition, other powertrain components, such as transmissions, universal joints, drive shafts, and front/rear axle components, can be stressed beyond design safety limits by the installation of these devices. General Motors does not support or endorse the use of devices or modifications that, when installed, increase the engine horsepower and torque. It is because of these unknown stresses, and the potential to alter reliability, durability and emissions performance, that GM has adopted a policy that prevents any UNAUTHORIZED dealer warranty claim submissions to any remaining warranty coverage, to the powertrain and driveline components whenever the presence of a non-GM (aftermarket) calibration is confirmed - even if the non-GM control module calibration is subsequently removed. Refer to the latest version of Bulletin 09-06-04-026 (V8 Gas Engines) or 06-06-01-007 (Duramax(TM) Diesel Engines) for more information on dealer requirements for calibration verification. These same policies apply as they relate to the use of non-GM accessories. Damage or failure from the use or installation of a non-GM accessory will not be covered under warranty. Failure resulting from the alteration or modification of the vehicle, including the cutting, welding or disconnecting of the vehicle's original equipment parts and components will void the warranty. Additionally, dealers will NOT be reimbursed or compensated by GM in the event of any legal inquiry at either the local, state or federal level that Page 6087 - Kostel - Molex - Sumitomo - Tyco/AMP - Yazaki Identifying the manufacturer of a connector is often difficult. When trying to determine the manufacturer of a connector, look for specific identifying marks that are unique to that connector supplier. Most of these identify marks are hard to find or see. Check the connector carefully and refer to the information below for pictures and descriptions of connector identification markings. - Most of AFLs connectors have EPC on their connector body. Some of the smaller connectors will not have any markings on them. - In some cases Bosch will actually be printed on the connector. If Bosch does not appear on the connector, look for the Bosch logo. The Bosch logo is a circle with a blunted arrow inside. This logo can appear anywhere on the connector and is often very small. Locations Lock Cylinder Switch: Locations Immobilizer Component Views Steering Wheel and Column Steering Wheel and Column 1 - Steering Wheel Control Switch Assembly - Upper Left (STW) 2 - Passlock Sensor Connector (w/o BAE) 3 - Ignition Key Alarm Switch 4 - Ignition Lock Cylinder Control Actuator 5 - Ignition Lock Cylinder Control Actuator Connector 6 - Ignition Switch 7 - Ignition Key Cylinder 8 - Steering Wheel Control Switch Assembly - Upper Right (STW) 9 - Horn Switch 10 - Steering Wheel Control Switch Assembly - Lower Right (STW) 11 - C277 12 - Steering Wheel Control Switch Assembly - Lower Left (STW) 13 - Turn Signal/Multifunction Switch Page 5996 3. Remove the dress cover by using a flat-blade tool to release the connector locking tabs and pulling off the dress cover. 4. Relieve the tension on the nose piece retainers by inserting J-38125-12A (12094429) into the single retainer slot on the end of the nose piece and gently prying out the locking tab. Repeat the process for both of the nose piece locking tabs on the opposite side of the nose piece. Page 6131 3. Ensure that the terminal release tang access panel is in the correct location to access the terminals. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) into the terminal release tang access slot located behind the access panel of the connector and press down on the terminal while carefully pulling the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Tyco/AMP Connectors (0.25 Cap) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (025 CAP) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component by pressing down on the connector position assurance (CPA). Page 2927 2. Remove the serpentine belt from the accessory drive system. 3. Install the tool onto the power steering pulley. Position the legs of the tool into the outer grooves of the pulley, farthest from the front of the engine. 4. Install the retaining cord around the pulley and to the legs of the tool. 5. Put on the laser safety glasses provided with the tool. 6. Depress the switch on the rear of the tool to activate the light beam. 7. Rotate the power steering pulley as required to project the light beam onto the crankshaft balancer pulley grooves. 8. Inspect for proper power steering pulley alignment. - If the laser beam projects onto the second rib or raised area (1), the pulleys are aligned properly. - If the laser beam projects more than one-quarter rib 0.9 mm (0.035 in) mis-alignment, adjust the position of the power steering pulley as required. - Refer to SI for Power Steering Pulley Removal and Installation procedures. 9. Install the serpentine belt to the accessory drive system in the original orientation. 10. Operate the vehicle and verify that the belt noise concern is no longer present. Tool Information Please visit the GM service tool website for pricing information or to place your order for this tool. Page 7566 Information Bus: Electrical Diagrams Body Control System Diagrams Body Control System Diagram 1 Page 6866 Page 8320 If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the DuraSeal splice sleeves. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: - Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. - Do not use the crimp and DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 to crimp DuraSeal splice sleeve. In order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 4362 All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system. Page 1967 MEASURING FREQUENCY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal. IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM to autorange to an appropriate range. 1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency measured. Measuring Voltage MEASURING VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit. 1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods: - Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. - Turn ON the engine. - Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls. - Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested. 3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The DMM displays the voltage measured at that point. Measuring Voltage Drop MEASURING VOLTAGE DROP NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points. Probing Electrical Connectors PROBING ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS Page 1883 REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. The release tab is located on the top of the wiredress cover. View of connector in released position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Page 3788 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert a small flat-blade tool in the slot below the front loaded terminal position assurance (TPA) and pry up. 3. Remove the TPA by pulling it out of the connector. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-553 (GM P/N 15315247) on a slight upward angle into the cavity below the terminal to be removed. Ensure that the pointed on the end of the tool is facing the bottom of the terminal and it stays in contact with the terminal until it stops on the plastic terminal retainer. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 5021 7. Remove the inlet hose from the water pump. 8. Using the J 38185, reposition the outlet hose clamp at the water pump. 9. Remove the outlet hose from the water pump. 10. Remove the auxiliary heater inlet and outlet hose/pipe nut. 11. Using the J 38185, reposition the throttle body hose clamp at the throttle body. 12. Remove the hose from the throttle body. 13. Using the J 38185, reposition the auxiliary heater inlet and outlet hose/pipe clamps at the water pump. 14. Remove the inlet and outlet hoses/pipes from the water pump. Page 8543 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert terminal into the appropriate terminal holder until it hits bottom and stops. The correct terminal holder is determined by the wire size. Also ensure that the terminals wings are pointing towards the former on the tool and the release locator. 5. Insert the stripped cable into the terminal. Insulation should be visible on both sides of the terminal insulation wings. 6. Compress the handles until the ratchet automatically releases. 7. Place the terminal into the appropriate cavity and assemble the connector. Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO-PACK 100W) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W connectors. These connectors are very similar but use different terminals and have some minor physical differences also. Page 301 Power Seat Control Module: Diagrams Memory Seat Module - Driver C3 Memory Seat Module - Driver C2 (w/Memory) Page 2426 vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide variety of actions, including: - Wiggling the harness - Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting - Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector - Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation - Relocating a harness or wires All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. Another option is, with the component commanded ON and OFF by the scan tool, move related connectors and wiring and observe the component operation. With the engine running, move related connectors and wiring while monitoring engine operation. If harness or connector movement affects the data displayed, component/system operation, or engine operation, inspect and repair the harness/connections as necessary. You may need to load the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these cases you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide good results as well. There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions, along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the circuit to these kinds of conditions. SALT WATER SPRAY Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture. Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5 percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously. HIGH TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070. Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault condition. The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis. This option does not allow for the same control, however. LOW TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect. If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to -18°C (0°F) from one end and +71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized cooling needs. Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or components in an effort to duplicate the concern. DUPLICATING FAILURE CONDITIONS - If none of the previous tests are successful, attempt to duplicate and/or capture the failure conditions. Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, where applicable, contains the conditions that were present when the DTC set. 1. Review and record Freeze Frame/Failure Records data. 2. Clear the DTCs using the scan tool. 3. Turn the key to OFF and wait 15 seconds. 4. Operate the vehicle under the same conditions that were noted in Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, as closely as possible. The vehicle must also be operating within the Conditions for Running the DTC. Refer to Conditions for Running the DTC in the supporting text if a DTC is being diagnosed. 5. Monitor DTC Status for the DTC being tested. The scan tool will indicate Ran, when the enabling conditions have been satisfied long enough for the DTC to run. The scan tool will also indicate whether the DTC passed or failed. - An alternate method is to drive the vehicle with the DMM connected to a suspected circuit. An abnormal reading on the DMM when the concern occurs, may help you locate the concern. Measuring Frequency Page 873 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 4480 to analyze the data during the time a vehicle condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a trigger point that you have determined. Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2 snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a first-in, first-out basis. If a third snapshot is taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost. Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types: Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice - Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200 frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not lost if the Scan Tool is powered down. The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis. The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected values by plotting 3 parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful, especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC. Testing for a Short to Voltage TESTING FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4. Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt, there is a short to voltage in the circuit. Testing for Continuity TESTING FOR CONTINUITY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6. Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit. 7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity. With a Test Lamp IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits. 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6. If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity. Testing for Electrical Intermittents TESTING FOR ELECTRICAL INTERMITTENTS Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment. - Testing for Short to Ground - Testing for Continuity - Testing for a Short to Voltage Page 8848 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert a small flat-blade tool in the slot below the front loaded terminal position assurance (TPA) and pry up. 3. Remove the TPA by pulling it out of the connector. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-553 (GM P/N 15315247) on a slight upward angle into the cavity below the terminal to be removed. Ensure that the pointed on the end of the tool is facing the bottom of the terminal and it stays in contact with the terminal until it stops on the plastic terminal retainer. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 7415 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches, and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original. - The wires insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the possibility of fuel contact. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1). 5. Select the proper duraseal splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool. Refer to the Crimp and Seal Splice Table. 6. Place the duraseal splice sleeve in the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115) crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 7. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to hold the duraseal splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 8. Insert the wires into the duraseal splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel in order to prevent the wire from passing through the splice (3). 9. Close the handles of the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115), until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is applied to the splice sleeve. 10. Shrink the insulation around the splice. - Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. - Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Splicing Inline Harness Diodes SPLICING INLINE HARNESS DIODES Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure. 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode. 2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool. 5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode. Page 7450 Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Remove the fuel tank. 2. Disconnect the fuel tank pressure sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove the fuel tank pressure sensor. Installation Procedure 1. Install the fuel tank pressure sensor. 2. Connect the fuel tank pressure sensor electrical connector. 3. Install the fuel tank. Page 6377 Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size. REPAIRING A FUSIBLE LINK IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient overload protection. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. Flat Wire Repairs FLAT WIRE REPAIRS NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced. GMLAN Wiring Repairs GMLAN WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The GM Local Area Network (GMLAN) System requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working on GMLAN connectors and terminals. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items in order to repair the GMLAN wiring: Dura Seal splice sleeves - A wire stripping tool - J 38125-8 Crimping Tool (GM P/N 12085115) - J 38125-5 Ultra Torch Special Tool (GM P/N 12085116) The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. - A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors GMLAN REPAIRS IMPORTANT: When making a repair to any GMLAN network, the original wire length after the repair must be the same length as before the repair. If the network is a twisted pair, the twist must be maintained after the repair is completed. GMLAN has 2 types of networks, low speed and high speed. Low speed GMLAN has a single wire and works at slow speeds. High speed GMLAN has 2 wires in a twisted pair and works at higher speeds. For more information on GMLAN, refer to Data Link Communications Description and Operation. GMLAN CONNECTOR TERMINAL REPAIR IMPORTANT: A service terminal can be used to replace damaged connector terminals for both high speed and low speed GMLAN systems. When making a connector terminal repair on a GMLAN high speed system with twisted pair wires, do not untwist the wires more than necessary to make the repair. The terminals in the GMLAN system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are available in the J-38125. If the individual terminals are damaged on any GMLAN connection, use the appropriate connector repair procedure in order to repair the terminal. GMLAN WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 547 Open the harness by removing any tape. 2. Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. 3. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 4. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent american wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 5. Slide a section of high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing down the length of wire to be spliced. Ensure that the shrink tubing will not interfere with the splice procedure. 6. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 7. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. 8. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 9. Insert the wire into the DuraSeal splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 10. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Page 5952 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (BSK) BOSCH CONNECTORS (BSK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 3. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 4. Insert the J 38125-561 tool into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 5. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is Page 6560 pulling it through. This will prevent damage to the internal seals of the connector. Once the terminal is pushed out of the connector, cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible and pull the wire through the connector. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE The Micro-Pack 100W connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool was developed to crimp Micro-Pack 100W terminals. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 2. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert the terminal into the crimp tool until the core wings are flush with the anvil on the crimp tool. Be sure that the wings are pointed toward the crimp tool former and release the spring locator. The locator will hold the terminal in place. Inspect the alignment of the terminal wings with the crimp tool former. If the terminal wings are wider than the crimp tool former, remove the terminal and bend the terminal wings in slightly. 5. Place stripped wire into terminal. 6. Crimp the new terminal to the wire. If a jam occurs, press the emergency release to open applicator. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire perform the following procedure in order to replace Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. Page 5071 Body Control Module: Diagrams Body Control Module (BCM) C2 Body Control Module (BCM) C2 Page 6403 Page 7772 5. Insert the J 38125-557 (GM P/N 12122378) into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 6. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Connector Position Assurance Locks CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of the connector. CPAs are used in various connectors throughout the vehicle. CPAs are also used in all SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals, of the connector. Connector Repairs CONNECTOR REPAIRS Page 7980 All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system. Page 904 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches, and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original. - The wires insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the possibility of fuel contact. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1). 5. Select the proper duraseal splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool. Refer to the Crimp and Seal Splice Table. 6. Place the duraseal splice sleeve in the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115) crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 7. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to hold the duraseal splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 8. Insert the wires into the duraseal splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel in order to prevent the wire from passing through the splice (3). 9. Close the handles of the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115), until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is applied to the splice sleeve. 10. Shrink the insulation around the splice. - Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. - Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Splicing Inline Harness Diodes SPLICING INLINE HARNESS DIODES Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure. 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode. 2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool. 5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode. Page 3372 5. Insert the J 38125-557 (GM P/N 12122378) into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 6. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Connector Position Assurance Locks CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of the connector. CPAs are used in various connectors throughout the vehicle. CPAs are also used in all SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals, of the connector. Connector Repairs CONNECTOR REPAIRS Page 7690 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link). - The wire insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. 5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold them between thumb and forefinger. 7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place. - Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction. - Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip. 8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool closes.Ensure that no strands of wire are cut. 10. Crimp the splice on each end (2). Page 1351 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) and slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. Page 3145 The dexos (TM) specification and trademarks are exclusive to General Motors, LLC. Only those oils displaying the dexos (TM) trademark and icon on the front label meet the demanding performance requirements and stringent quality standards set forth in the dexos (TM)specification. Look on the front label for any of the logos shown above to identify an authorized, licensed dexos 2(TM) engine oil. GM dexos 2(TM) Engine Oil Specification - dexos 2(TM) is approved and recommended by GM for use in Europe starting in model year 2010 vehicles, regardless of where the vehicle was manufactured. - dexos 2(TM) is the recommended service fill oil for European gasoline engines. Important The Duramax(TM) diesel engine is the exception and requires lubricants meeting specification CJ-4. - dexos 2(TM) is the recommended service fill oil for European light-duty diesel engines and replaces GM-LL-B-025 and GM-LL-A-025. - dexos 2(TM) protects diesel engines from harmful soot deposits and is designed with limits on certain chemical components to prolong catalyst life and protect expensive emission reduction systems. It is a robust oil, resisting degradation between oil changes and maintaining optimum performance longer. Disclaimer Page 2481 8. Insert the J 38125-213 into the small terminal release hole on the nose piece and gently pull on the back of the wire. 9. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Repairing Connector Terminals REPAIRING CONNECTOR TERMINALS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following: Push to Seat terminals - Pull to Seat terminals Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your terminal repair. The J-38125 contains further information. 1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.For cable seal terminals, remove the seal. 2. Apply the correct cable seal per gage size of the wire, if used.Slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation removal. 3. Remove the insulation. 4. For sealed terminals only, align the seal with the end of the cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal.For sealed terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal. 6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.For sealed terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable. 8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals excepting Micro-Pack 100.64 size. Soldering Micro-Pack 100 World terminals may damage the terminal. Sumitomo Connectors SUMITOMO CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 8818 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the TPA. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the nose piece. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. Page 387 4. Once the front 2 locks are unlocked, lift the front of the dress cover and pull it forward. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the small slot on the TPA and pushing down until the TPA releases. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to angle or rock the J 38125-21 tool when inserting it into the connector or the tool may break. Insert the J 38125-21 (GM P/N 15381651-2) tool into the round canal between the terminals cavities at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to repair Micro 64 connector terminals. The Micro 64 connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-64 (M jaw) was developed to crimp Micro 64 terminals. The J 38125-64 crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. The J 38125-64 crimping tool is also designed to crimp both the wire and the insulation at the same time. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro 64 terminals. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. 1. Cut the wire as close to the damaged terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. Page 6347 2. Locate the two indents of the terminal position assurance (TPA) located on the bottom of the connector body. Page 2242 Release the lower wiredress cover locking tab. Release the upper wiredress cover locking tab. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. Page 1249 Headlamp Switch C2 Page 7020 Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested: - Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. - Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a component or to other harnesses. - If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A TEST LAMP TOOLS REQUIRED J 35616-200 Test Light - Probe Kit NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminate even though voltage is present. The J 35616-200 is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair of leads. To properly operate this tool use the following procedures. When testing for voltage: 1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested. When testing for ground: 1. Attach one lead to battery positive voltage. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where ground should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is ground at the point being tested. Using Connector Test Adapters USING CONNECTOR TEST ADAPTERS NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Using Fused Jumper Wires USING FUSED JUMPER WIRES TOOLS REQUIRED J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged. The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested. AFL/ECP Connectors AFL/EPC CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 5259 5. Insert the ECM into the retaining slots of the ECM/TCM bracket. 6. Secure the ECM to the bracket ensuring that the ECM retaining tabs (1) are fully engaged. 7. Connect the engine wiring harness electrical connectors to the ECM. Page 5980 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the TPA. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the nose piece. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. Page 4405 The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors. 1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position. 4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool J 38125-10A (GM P/N 12014012-1) into the front (mating end) of the connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal through the back of the connector (2). IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector. 6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. 7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily. 10. Perform system check. Delphi Connectors (12 Way) DELPHI CONNECTORS (12-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. Locations Body Control Module (BCM) Page 2087 Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Page 2650 Page 6932 3. Remove the dress cover by using a flat-blade tool to release the connector locking tabs and pulling off the dress cover. 4. Relieve the tension on the nose piece retainers by inserting J-38125-12A (12094429) into the single retainer slot on the end of the nose piece and gently prying out the locking tab. Repeat the process for both of the nose piece locking tabs on the opposite side of the nose piece. Page 2215 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (BSK) BOSCH CONNECTORS (BSK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 3. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 4. Insert the J 38125-561 tool into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 5. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is Page 6141 Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size. REPAIRING A FUSIBLE LINK IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient overload protection. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. Flat Wire Repairs FLAT WIRE REPAIRS NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced. GMLAN Wiring Repairs GMLAN WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The GM Local Area Network (GMLAN) System requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working on GMLAN connectors and terminals. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items in order to repair the GMLAN wiring: Dura Seal splice sleeves - A wire stripping tool - J 38125-8 Crimping Tool (GM P/N 12085115) - J 38125-5 Ultra Torch Special Tool (GM P/N 12085116) The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. - A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors GMLAN REPAIRS IMPORTANT: When making a repair to any GMLAN network, the original wire length after the repair must be the same length as before the repair. If the network is a twisted pair, the twist must be maintained after the repair is completed. GMLAN has 2 types of networks, low speed and high speed. Low speed GMLAN has a single wire and works at slow speeds. High speed GMLAN has 2 wires in a twisted pair and works at higher speeds. For more information on GMLAN, refer to Data Link Communications Description and Operation. GMLAN CONNECTOR TERMINAL REPAIR IMPORTANT: A service terminal can be used to replace damaged connector terminals for both high speed and low speed GMLAN systems. When making a connector terminal repair on a GMLAN high speed system with twisted pair wires, do not untwist the wires more than necessary to make the repair. The terminals in the GMLAN system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are available in the J-38125. If the individual terminals are damaged on any GMLAN connection, use the appropriate connector repair procedure in order to repair the terminal. GMLAN WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 5938 Checking Aftermarket Accessories CHECKING AFTERMARKET ACCESSORIES Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits: - CAUTION: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol. - NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice. OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol. Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the cause of the problems. Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include: Power feeds connected to points other than the battery - Antenna location - Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring - Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line - Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories. Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions INDUCING INTERMITTENT FAULT CONDITIONS TOOLS REQUIRED J 25070 Heat Gun Many intermittent open or shorted circuits are affected by harness/connector movement that is caused by vibration, engine torque, bumps/rough pavement, etc. In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness if the malfunction appears to be Page 872 8. Insert the J 38125-213 into the small terminal release hole on the nose piece and gently pull on the back of the wire. 9. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Repairing Connector Terminals REPAIRING CONNECTOR TERMINALS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following: Push to Seat terminals - Pull to Seat terminals Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your terminal repair. The J-38125 contains further information. 1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.For cable seal terminals, remove the seal. 2. Apply the correct cable seal per gage size of the wire, if used.Slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation removal. 3. Remove the insulation. 4. For sealed terminals only, align the seal with the end of the cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal.For sealed terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal. 6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.For sealed terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable. 8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals excepting Micro-Pack 100.64 size. Soldering Micro-Pack 100 World terminals may damage the terminal. Sumitomo Connectors SUMITOMO CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 8561 View of typical connector. View of connector in released position. 1. Locate the assist lever at the back of the connector. Move the assist lever to the rear position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the dress cover. Page 2095 It is very important to use the correct test adapter when testing for proper terminal contact of fuses and relays in a bussed electrical center (BEC). Use J-35616-35 to test for proper terminal contact. Failure to use J-35616-35 can result in improper diagnosis of the BEC. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Separate the connector halves. 2. Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body. 3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J-38125 , test that the retention force is significantly different between a good terminal and a suspect terminal. Replace the female terminal in question. FLAT WIRE (DOCK AND LOCK) CONNECTORS There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock) connectors on the harness side or the component side. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Remove the component in question. 2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side of the connector as oil from your skin may be a source of contamination as well. 3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other imperfections that could cause poor terminal contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are uniform and free of damage or deformation. 4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the on the flat wire harness connector in order to test the circuit in question. CONTROL MODULE/COMPONENT VOLTAGE AND GROUNDS Poor voltage or ground connections can cause widely varying symptoms. Test all control module voltage supply circuits. Many vehicles have multiple circuits supplying voltage to a control module. Other components in the system may have separate voltage supply circuits that may also need to be tested. Inspect connections at the module/component connectors, fuses, and any intermediate connections between the voltage source and the module/component. A test lamp or a DMM may indicate that voltage is present, but neither tests the ability of the circuit to carry sufficient current. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Power Distribution Schematics. - Test all control module ground and system ground circuits. The control module may have multiple ground circuits. Other components in the system may have separate grounds that may also need to be tested. Inspect grounds for clean and tight connections at the grounding point. Inspect the connections at the component and in splice packs, where applicable. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Ground Distribution Schematics. TEMPERATURE SENSITIVITY - An intermittent condition may occur when a component/connection reaches normal operating temperature. The condition may occur only when the component/connection is cold, or only when the component/connection is hot. - Freeze Frame, Failure Records, Snapshot, or Vehicle Data Recorder data may help with this type of intermittent condition, where applicable. - If the intermittent is related to heat, review the data for a relationship with the following: High ambient temperatures - Underhood/engine generated heat - Circuit generated heat due to a poor connection, or high electrical load - Higher than normal load conditions, towing, etc. - If the intermittent is related to cold, review the data for the following: Low ambient temperatures-In extremely low temperatures, ice may form in a connection or component. Inspect for water intrusion. - The condition only occurs on a cold start. - The condition goes away when the vehicle warms up. - Information from the customer may help to determine if the trouble follows a pattern that is temperature related. - If temperature is suspected of causing an intermittent fault condition, attempt to duplicate the condition. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required. ELECTROMAGNETIC INTERFERENCE (EMI) AND ELECTRICAL NOISE Some electrical components/circuits are sensitive to electromagnetic interference (EMI) or other types of electrical noise. Inspect for the following conditions: A misrouted harness that is too close to high voltage/high current devices such as secondary ignition components, motors, generator etc-These components may induce electrical noise on a circuit that could interfere with normal circuit operation. - Electrical system interference caused by a malfunctioning relay, or a control module driven solenoid or switch-These conditions can cause a sharp electrical surge. Normally, the condition will occur when the malfunctioning component is operating. - Improper installation of non-factory or aftermarket add on accessories such as lights, 2-way radios, amplifiers, electric motors, remote starters, alarm systems, cell phones, etc-These accessories may lead to interference while in use, but do not fail when the accessories are not in use. - Test for an open diode across the A/C compressor clutch and for other open diodes. Some relays may contain a clamping diode. - The generator may be allowing AC noise into the electrical system. INCORRECT CONTROL MODULE - There are only a few situations where reprogramming a control module is appropriate: A new service control module is installed. Drive Belt Chirping, Squeal, and Whine Diagnosis Drive Belt: Testing and Inspection Drive Belt Chirping, Squeal, and Whine Diagnosis Drive Belt Chirping, Squeal, and Whine Diagnosis Diagnostic Aids ^ A chirping or squeal noise may be intermittent due to moisture on the drive belts or the pulleys. It may be necessary to spray a small amount of water on the drive belts in order to duplicate the customers concern. If spraying water on the drive belt duplicates the symptom, cleaning the belt pulleys may be the probable solution. ^ If the noise is intermittent, verify the accessory drive components by varying their loads making sure they are operated to their maximum capacity. An overcharged A/C system, power steering system with a pinched hose or wrong fluid, or a generator failing are suggested items to inspect. ^ A chirping, squeal or whine noise may be caused by a loose or improper installation of a body or suspension component. Other items of the vehicle may also cause the noise. ^ The drive belts will not cause a whine noise. Test Description The numbers below refer to the step numbers on the diagnostic table. 2. The noise may not be engine related. This step is to verify that the engine is making the noise. If the engine is not making the noise do not proceed further with this table. 3. The noise may be an internal engine noise. Removing the drive belts one at a time and operating the engine for a brief period will verify the noise is related to the drive belt. When removing the drive belt the water pump may not be operating and the engine may overheat. Also DTCs may set when the engine is operating with the drive belts removed. 4. Inspect all drive belt pulleys for pilling. Pilling is the small balls or pills or it can be strings in the drive belt grooves from the accumulation of rubber dust. 6. Misalignment of the pulleys may be caused from improper mounting of the accessory drive component, incorrect installation of the accessory drive component pulley, or the pulley bent inward or outward from a previous repair. Test for a misaligned pulley using a straight edge in the pulley grooves across 2 or 3 pulleys. If a misaligned pulley is found refer to that accessory drive component for the proper installation procedure for that pulley. 10. Inspecting of the fasteners can eliminate the possibility that a wrong bolt, nut, spacer, or washer was installed. 12. Inspecting the pulleys for being bent should include inspecting for a dent or other damage to the pulleys that would prevent the drive belt from not seating properly in all of the pulley grooves or on the smooth surface of a pulley when the back side of the belt is used to drive the pulley. 14. This test is to verify that the drive belt tensioner operates properly. If the drive belt tensioner is not operating properly, proper belt tension may not be achieved to keep the drive belt from slipping which could cause a squeal noise. 15. This test is to verify that the drive belt is not too long, which would prevent the drive belt tensioner from working properly. Also if an incorrect length drive belt was installed, it may not be routed properly and may be turning an accessory drive component in the wrong direction. 16. Misalignment of the pulleys may be caused from improper mounting of the accessory drive component, incorrect installation of the accessory drive component pulley, or the pulley bent inward or outward from a previous repair. Test for a misaligned pulley using a straight edge in the pulley grooves across 2 or 3 pulleys. If a misaligned pulley is found refer to that accessory drive component for the proper installation procedure for that pulley. 17. This test is to verify that the pulleys are the correct diameter or width. Using a known good vehicle compare the pulley sizes. 19. Replacing the drive belt when it is not damaged or there is not excessive pilling will only be a temporary repair. Page 8664 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (BSK) BOSCH CONNECTORS (BSK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 3. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 4. Insert the J 38125-561 tool into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 5. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is Locations Body Control Module (BCM) Page 8326 5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape. Seat Belt Schematic Icons Seat Belt Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons Page 8043 5. Once the nose piece retainers are relaxed, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should raise slightly. 6. On the opposite side of the nose piece, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should release completely. If the nose piece does not come off, repeat the procedure on the opposite side. Page 4258 1. Relieve the fuel system pressure, if required. Perform the following steps: Caution: Wrap a shop towel around the fuel pressure connection in order to reduce the risk of fire and personal injury. The towel will absorb any fuel leakage that occurs during the connection of the fuel pressure gage. Place the towel in an approved container when the connection of the fuel pressure gage is complete. 1. Wrap a shop towel around the fuel rail service port. 2. Place the hose on the CH-48027-2 (2) into an approved gasoline container. 3. Open the valve on the CH-48027-2 (2) in order to bleed any fuel from the fuel rail. 4. Close the valve on the CH-48027-2 (2). 5. Remove the hose on the CH-48027-2 (2) from the approved gasoline container. 6. Remove the shop towel from around the fuel rail service port, and place in an approved gasoline container. Notice: Clean all of the following areas before performing any disconnections in order to avoid possible contamination in the system: * The fuel pipe connections * The hose connections * The areas surrounding the connections Disconnect the CH-48027-1 (1) from the CH-48027-2 (2). 2. Disconnect the CH-48027-2 (2) from the CH-48027-3 (4). 3. Disconnect the CH-48027-3 (4) from the fuel rail service port. 4. Install the fuel rail service port cap. 5. Tighten the fuel fill cap. Page 5541 5. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove TPA from the connector. 6. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Page 6222 7. Apply pressure and gently rock the cover until one locking leg is unseated. 8. Continue to apply pressure and rock the cover until the second locking leg is unseated. Repeat procedure for the other side of the dress cover and remove the cover. 9. Use J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) to gently lift the terminal retaining tab while gently pulling the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 10. If the terminal is severely bent or damaged, it may be possible on some connectors to push the wire out of the front of the connector instead of Page 424 2. Use a small flat-bladed tool to release the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting the tool in the small recess on the side of the connector and pushing up until the TPA releases from the connector body. The TPA should raise just slightly. Do not try to remove the TPA. IMPORTANT: The TPA on this connector cannot be removed unless the terminals are removed first. The TPA will come out of the connector body, but only slightly. When the TPA is slightly raised the terminals can be removed. Using excessive force to remove the TPA with the terminals still in the connector will damage the connector. 3. Repeat the process for the other side of the connector. 4. Ensure that the TPA is in the proper position to remove the terminals. Page 8086 Engine Control Module (ECM) C3 (Pin 60 To 73) Page 6120 8. Insert the J 38125-213 into the small terminal release hole on the nose piece and gently pull on the back of the wire. 9. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Repairing Connector Terminals REPAIRING CONNECTOR TERMINALS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following: Push to Seat terminals - Pull to Seat terminals Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your terminal repair. The J-38125 contains further information. 1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.For cable seal terminals, remove the seal. 2. Apply the correct cable seal per gage size of the wire, if used.Slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation removal. 3. Remove the insulation. 4. For sealed terminals only, align the seal with the end of the cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal.For sealed terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal. 6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.For sealed terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable. 8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals excepting Micro-Pack 100.64 size. Soldering Micro-Pack 100 World terminals may damage the terminal. Sumitomo Connectors SUMITOMO CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 1015 4. Install the shroud to the steering wheel. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 5. Install the shroud retaining screws to the steering wheel. Tighten the screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in). 6. Install the steering wheel. Page 5994 8. Insert the J 38125-213 into the small terminal release hole on the nose piece and gently pull on the back of the wire. 9. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Repairing Connector Terminals REPAIRING CONNECTOR TERMINALS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following: Push to Seat terminals - Pull to Seat terminals Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your terminal repair. The J-38125 contains further information. 1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.For cable seal terminals, remove the seal. 2. Apply the correct cable seal per gage size of the wire, if used.Slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation removal. 3. Remove the insulation. 4. For sealed terminals only, align the seal with the end of the cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal.For sealed terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal. 6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.For sealed terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable. 8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals excepting Micro-Pack 100.64 size. Soldering Micro-Pack 100 World terminals may damage the terminal. Sumitomo Connectors SUMITOMO CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 5298 3. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. View showing depressing of the lever lock release tab. Page 8450 View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. 4. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers CIRCUIT PROTECTION - CIRCUIT BREAKERS A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types of circuit Page 5246 Engine Control Module (ECM) C1 (Pin 1 To 15) Page 4887 Checking Aftermarket Accessories CHECKING AFTERMARKET ACCESSORIES Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits: - CAUTION: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol. - NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice. OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol. Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the cause of the problems. Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include: Power feeds connected to points other than the battery - Antenna location - Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring - Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line - Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories. Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions INDUCING INTERMITTENT FAULT CONDITIONS TOOLS REQUIRED J 25070 Heat Gun Many intermittent open or shorted circuits are affected by harness/connector movement that is caused by vibration, engine torque, bumps/rough pavement, etc. In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness if the malfunction appears to be Page 531 4. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the rear of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. 5. Once the locking tabs are unlocked, slide the inner connector out of the rear of the connector housing. Page 6612 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches, and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original. - The wires insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the possibility of fuel contact. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1). 5. Select the proper duraseal splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool. Refer to the Crimp and Seal Splice Table. 6. Place the duraseal splice sleeve in the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115) crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 7. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to hold the duraseal splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 8. Insert the wires into the duraseal splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel in order to prevent the wire from passing through the splice (3). 9. Close the handles of the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115), until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is applied to the splice sleeve. 10. Shrink the insulation around the splice. - Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. - Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Splicing Inline Harness Diodes SPLICING INLINE HARNESS DIODES Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure. 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode. 2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool. 5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode. Page 2602 REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. The release tab is located on the top of the wiredress cover. View of connector in released position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Page 1582 IMPORTANT: Ensure that the dress cover and connector body are both in the released position before reassembling. Failure to do so may cause damage to the connector and component. Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (0.64) BOSCH CONNECTORS (0.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While pressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock until the lever is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Pull the rubber boot that covers the wires back to expose the end of the connector dress cover. 4. Place the connector locking lever in the center of the connector. 5. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs that are on the wire end of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover and connector body and pry up. Page 762 11. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 12. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 13. Center the high temperature SCT1 shrink tube over the DuraSeal splice sleeve. 14. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the high temperature heat shrink tubing. 15. Gradually move the heat from the center to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 16. Replace any reflective tape and clips that may have been remove during the repair. Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation REPAIRING DAMAGED WIRE INSULATION Wire Size Conversion Page 6732 View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. 4. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers CIRCUIT PROTECTION - CIRCUIT BREAKERS A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types of circuit Page 350 Page 7182 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert terminal into the appropriate terminal holder until it hits bottom and stops. The correct terminal holder is determined by the wire size. Also ensure that the terminals wings are pointing towards the former on the tool and the release locator. 5. Insert the stripped cable into the terminal. Insulation should be visible on both sides of the terminal insulation wings. 6. Compress the handles until the ratchet automatically releases. 7. Place the terminal into the appropriate cavity and assemble the connector. Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO-PACK 100W) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W connectors. These connectors are very similar but use different terminals and have some minor physical differences also. Page 1171 Discharge Air Temperature Sensor / Switch: Diagrams HVAC Connector End Views Air Temperature Sensor - Lower Left Air Temperature Sensor - Lower Right Air Temperature Sensor - Upper Left Restraints - Air Bag Lamp ON/Multiple DTC Set Air Bag Control Module: Customer Interest Restraints - Air Bag Lamp ON/Multiple DTC Set TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 08-09-41-002F Date: June 10, 2010 Subject: Diagnostic Information for Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System, Intermittent AIR BAG Indicator/Lamp Illuminated with DTC(s) B0012, B0013, B0015, B0016, B0019, B0020, B0022, B0023, B0026, B0033, B0040, B0042 or B0044 Set (Inspect and Replace Connector Position Assurance (CPA) Retainer) Models: 2005-2007 Buick Rainier 2006-2009 Buick Allure (Canada only), LaCrosse, Lucerne 2008-2010 Buick Enclave 2006-2010 Cadillac DTS 2007-2010 Cadillac Escalade Models 2008-2009 Cadillac SRX, XLR 2008-2010 Cadillac CTS, STS 2005-2006 Chevrolet SSR 2005-2009 Chevrolet TrailBlazer, TrailBlazer EXT 2005-2010 Chevrolet Cobalt 2006-2007 Chevrolet Monte Carlo 2006-2010 Chevrolet Corvette, HHR, Impala, Malibu Models (includes Malibu Classic) 2007-2009 Chevrolet Equinox 2007-2010 Chevrolet Avalanche, Silverado, Suburban, Tahoe 2008-2010 Chevrolet Express 2009-2010 Chevrolet Traverse 2005-2009 GMC Envoy Models 2007-2010 GMC Acadia, Sierra, Yukon, Yukon Denali, Yukon XL, Yukon Denali XL 2008-2010 GMC Savana 2005-2006 Pontiac Pursuit 2005-2009 Pontiac G6 2006-2009 Pontiac Solstice 2007-2009 Pontiac G5, Torrent 2008-2009 Pontiac G8 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X 2007-2009 Saturn AURA, OUTLOOK, SKY 2008-2009 Saturn VUE 2008-2009 HUMMER H2 2007-2008 Daewoo G2X 2007-2009 Opel GT Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the Warranty Information and add Saab Warranty Information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 08-09-41-002E (Section 09 Restraints). Condition - Some customers may comment on an intermittent or current AIR BAG indicator or lamp being illuminated on the instrument panel cluster (IPC). Important This bulletin only applies to the following DTCs: - Technicians may observe DTC(s) B0012 04, 0D, 0E; B0013 04, 0D, 0E; B0015 04, 0D, 0E; B0016 04, 0D, 0E; B0019 04, 0D, 0E; B0020 04, 0D, 0E; B0022, B0023 04, 0D, 0E; B0033 04, 0D, 0E; B0040 04, 0D, 0E; B0042 or B0044 set as Current or in History in the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM). Cause This condition may be caused by a loose, missing, or damaged connector position assurance (CPA) retainer at a supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) module electrical connector, or a deployment loop wiring harness electrical connector. Correction Page 5465 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry one side of the nose piece up to the pre-stage position. When the nose piece is in the pre-staged position, the nose piece will be raised above the connector body the length of the step in the nose piece. 7. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry the other side of the piece to the pre-stage position. If the nose piece is higher than the first step in the nose piece, gently push down on the nose piece until it meets with resistance from the connector body, you should feel the nose piece click into position. Page 6591 3. Ensure that the terminal release tang access panel is in the correct location to access the terminals. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) into the terminal release tang access slot located behind the access panel of the connector and press down on the terminal while carefully pulling the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Tyco/AMP Connectors (0.25 Cap) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (025 CAP) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component by pressing down on the connector position assurance (CPA). Page 6435 - In some cases Delphi will actually be printed on the connector. If Delphi is not printed on the connector, look for PED. In both cases there is no specific orientation for Delphi or PED and they can appear anywhere on the connector. - FCI connectors may have the FCI logo on their connectors. The logo is the letters FCI with an "A" above it. - JAE connector have JAE in small letters on their connectors. Page 5445 7. Apply pressure and gently rock the cover until one locking leg is unseated. 8. Continue to apply pressure and rock the cover until the second locking leg is unseated. Repeat procedure for the other side of the dress cover and remove the cover. 9. Use J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) to gently lift the terminal retaining tab while gently pulling the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 10. If the terminal is severely bent or damaged, it may be possible on some connectors to push the wire out of the front of the connector instead of Page 2788 Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagrams Vehicle Speed Sensor Assembly, Wiring Harness Side Vehicle Speed Sensor Assembly, Wiring Harness Side Vehicle Speed Sensor Assembly, Wiring Harness Side Page 3217 Fuse Block - Underhood (5.3L/6.0L), Label Usage Locations Headlamp Wiper Relay: Locations Fuse Block - Underhood (5.3L/6.0L), Label Electrical - Aftermarket Fuse Warning Fuse: Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - Aftermarket Fuse Warning Bulletin No.: 07-08-45-002 Date: September 05, 2007 ADVANCED SERVICE INFORMATION Subject: Service Alert: Concerns With Aftermarket Fuses in GM Vehicles Models: 2008 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2008 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2008 and Prior Saab 9-7X Concerns with Harbor Freight Tools "Storehouse" Branded Blade Type Fuses General Motors has become aware of a fuse recall by Harbor Freight Tools/Storehouse for a variety of aftermarket fuses. In two cases, these fuses have not provided protection for the wiring system of the vehicles they were customer installed in. Upon testing the 15 amp version, it was found that the fuse still would not "open" when shorted directly across the battery terminals. How to Identify These Fuses Packed in a 120 piece set, the fuse has a translucent, hard plastic, blue body with the amperage stamped into the top. There are no white painted numbers on the fuse to indicate amperage. There are no identifying marks on the fuse to tell who is making it. The fuses are known to be distributed by Harbor Freight Tools but there may be other marketers, and packaging of this style of fuse. It would be prudent to replace these fuses if found in a customers vehicle. Likewise, if wiring overheating is found you should check the fuse panel for the presence of this style of fuse. All GM dealers should use genuine GM fuses on the vehicles they service. You should also encourage the use of GM fuses to your customers to assure they are getting the required electrical system protection. GM has no knowledge of any concerns with other aftermarket fuses. If additional information becomes available, this bulletin will be updated. Disclaimer Page 557 US English/Metric Conversion US English/Metric Conversion Page 8119 Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids Arrows and Symbols Arrows and Symbols This Service Data uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations. Arrows and Symbols 1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow Basic Knowledge Required GENERAL ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures contained in the service manual. You should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current (amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram, as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. Decimal and Metric Equivalents Decimal and Metric Equivalents Page 7128 Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under the 5 year / 100,000 mile (160,000 km) emission warranty, use: Warranty Information (Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 1886 2. Locate the two indents of the terminal position assurance (TPA) located on the bottom of the connector body. Page 3973 4. Install the valve rocker arm cover onto the cylinder head. 5. Install new rocker arm cover grommets, if necessary. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 6. Install the rocker arm cover bolts and grommets. Tighten the bolts to 12 N.m (106 lb in). 7. Install the vent hose (2) to the valve rocker arm cover (1). Engine/Transmission - Aftermarket Calibrations Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine/Transmission - Aftermarket Calibrations INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 09-06-04-026B Date: April 07, 2010 Subject: Identifying Non-GM (Aftermarket) Engine and Transmission Calibrations for V8 Gas Engines Using Tech 2(R) or Global Diagnostic System (GDS) Models: 2006-2010 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Excluding Saab 9-7X) 2006-2009 HUMMER H2 2006-2010 HUMMER H3 Equipped with V8 Gas Powered Engines Only Attention: This bulletin applies to V8 gas powered engines ONLY. For Duramax(TM) diesel powered engines, refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 08-06-04-006G. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2010 model year and information about retrieving calibrations on a Global A vehicle. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 09-06-04-026A (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). General Motors is identifying an increasing number of engine, transmission and catalytic converter part failures that are the result of non-GM (aftermarket) engine and transmission control calibrations being used. When alteration to the GM-released engine or transmission control calibrations occurs, it subjects powertrain and driveline components (engine, transmission, transfer case, driveshaft and rear axle) to stresses that were not tested by General Motors. It is because of these unknown stresses, and the potential to alter reliability, durability and emissions performance, that GM has adopted a policy that prevents any UNAUTHORIZED dealer warranty claim submissions to any remaining warranty coverage, to the powertrain and driveline components whenever the presence of a non-GM (aftermarket) calibration is confirmed - even if the non-GM control module calibration is subsequently removed. Warranty coverage is based on the equipment and calibrations that were released on the vehicle at time of sale, or subsequently updated by GM. That's because GM testing and validation matches the calibration to a host of criteria that is essential to assure reliability, durability and emissions performance over the life of the warranty coverage and beyond. Stresses resulting from calibrations different from those tested and released by GM can damage or weaken components, leading to poor performance and or shortened life. Additionally, non-GM (aftermarket) issued engine control modifications often do not meet the same emissions performance standards as GM issued calibrations. Depending on state statutes, individuals who install engine control module calibrations that put the vehicle outside the parameters of emissions certification standards may be subject to fines and/or penalties. This bulletin outlines a procedure to identify the presence of non-GM (aftermarket) calibrations. GM recommends performing this check whenever a hard part failure is seen on internal engine or transmission components, or before an engine assembly or transmission assembly is being replaced under warranty. It is also recommended that the engine calibration verification procedure be performed whenever diagnostics indicate that catalytic converter replacement is indicated. The PQC has a process to confirm the ECM/PCM calibration is GM issued. The PQC will require a picture of the engine calibration verification screen, as outlined in this bulletin, before authorizing any V8 gas powered engine replacement. If a non-GM calibration is found and verification has taken place through GM, the remaining powertrain and driveline warranty will be blocked and notated in GMVIS and the dealership will be notified. This block prevents any UNAUTHORIZED warranty claim submission. 1. Connect the Tech 2(R) to the vehicle. 2. Go to: Diagnostics and build the vehicle. 3. Select: Powertrain. 4. Select: Engine. 5. *Select: Engine Control Module or PCM. 6. *Select: Module ID Information or I/M Information System if the Module ID Information selection is not available. 7. *If "I/M information System" was selected, it may be necessary to select "Vehicle Information" in order to display the calibration information. ‹› If the CVN information is displayed as "N/A", it will be necessary to contact the TCSC to obtain the CVN information. Page 9066 7. The illustration above identifies the entry canal where the terminal release tool will be inserted, and the terminal cavity. - Terminal (1) - Entry Canal (2) 8. Insert the J-38125-553 (15315247) tool into the entry canal and pry up on the terminal retainer. The terminal retainer is a small plastic piece on the top of the terminal. The terminal retainer must be held up while the terminal is pulled out of the connector. Page 3371 11. Insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) into the 2 triangular cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 12. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE 1. Prior to installation the terminal must be aligned so the (1) coding lugs align with the (2) coding grooves on the connector. 2. Once the terminal is aligned, slide the terminal into the cavity until the retainer has engaged in the cavity of the connector. 3. Slide the TPA in the connector body and seat it using a small flat bladed tool. The TPA is seated when it is flush with the contact housing. 4. Secure the wires to the connector body using a tie wrap and replace the dress cover and grommet. Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) BOSCH CONNECTORS (2.8 JPT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Pull out the slider on the connector position assurance (CPA) until it is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 1414 Page 4862 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the DuraSeal splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of a connector. CPAs are used in all SIR System connectors and also in some connectors of other systems. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals of a connection. TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE CLIPS IMPORTANT: When making a splice in an area that may be exposed to moisture use a crimp and seal splice sleeve instead of a Splice Clip. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. Page 3720 Refer to the following table as a guide in selecting the correct test adapter for front probing connectors: Backprobe IMPORTANT: Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures. - Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector. - Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large of a test probe. - After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected, test for proper terminal contact. Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the connector. Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure SCAN TOOL SNAPSHOT PROCEDURE Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used Page 2897 1. Install the MAF/IAT sensor (3) to the air filter element (6). 2. Install the air filter element (6) and MAF/IAT sensor (3) to the lower air cleaner housing/washer solvent tank assembly (4). Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. Important: Ensure the air inlet duct (5) is properly positioned in the lower air cleaner housing/washer solvent tank assembly (4) before installing the air cleaner cover (2). 3. Install the air cleaner cover (2) and secure with 4 retaining screws (1). Tighten the screws to 4 N.m (35 lb in). 4. Install the radiator support diagonal brace. 5. Connect the MAF/IAT sensor electrical connector (1). 6. Install the air cleaner outlet duct. Page 6312 View of connector in released position. 4. Disconnect the connector from the component. 5. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Release the rear lower half of the wiredress cover. Page 1542 Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under the 5 year / 100,000 mile (160,000 km) emission warranty, use: Warranty Information (Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 5819 11. Insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) into the 2 triangular cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 12. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE 1. Prior to installation the terminal must be aligned so the (1) coding lugs align with the (2) coding grooves on the connector. 2. Once the terminal is aligned, slide the terminal into the cavity until the retainer has engaged in the cavity of the connector. 3. Slide the TPA in the connector body and seat it using a small flat bladed tool. The TPA is seated when it is flush with the contact housing. 4. Secure the wires to the connector body using a tie wrap and replace the dress cover and grommet. Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) BOSCH CONNECTORS (2.8 JPT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Pull out the slider on the connector position assurance (CPA) until it is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Locations Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Locations Fuse Block - Underhood (5.3L/6.0L), Label Page 6927 MOLEX CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. 2. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. Page 5412 MEASURING FREQUENCY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal. IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM to autorange to an appropriate range. 1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency measured. Measuring Voltage MEASURING VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit. 1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods: - Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. - Turn ON the engine. - Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls. - Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested. 3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The DMM displays the voltage measured at that point. Measuring Voltage Drop MEASURING VOLTAGE DROP NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points. Probing Electrical Connectors PROBING ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS Page 3459 Fuse Block - Underhood C1 (5.3L/6.0L) Page 2936 Step 1 - Step 10 Page 4234 7. Remove the crankshaft sprocket (207). 8. Remove the crankshaft sprocket key, as required. Installation Procedure 1. Install the key into the crankshaft keyway, if previously removed. Page 5835 pulling it through. This will prevent damage to the internal seals of the connector. Once the terminal is pushed out of the connector, cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible and pull the wire through the connector. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE The Micro-Pack 100W connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool was developed to crimp Micro-Pack 100W terminals. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 2. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert the terminal into the crimp tool until the core wings are flush with the anvil on the crimp tool. Be sure that the wings are pointed toward the crimp tool former and release the spring locator. The locator will hold the terminal in place. Inspect the alignment of the terminal wings with the crimp tool former. If the terminal wings are wider than the crimp tool former, remove the terminal and bend the terminal wings in slightly. 5. Place stripped wire into terminal. 6. Crimp the new terminal to the wire. If a jam occurs, press the emergency release to open applicator. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire perform the following procedure in order to replace Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. Page 4839 3. Use a small flat-bladed tool to gently pry off the dress cover by inserting the tool under the cover opposite the harness side and prying up. 4. Remove the cover. 5. Using a small flat-bladed tool, push on the side of the nose piece retainer while pushing the nose piece forward with your thumb. This will release the terminal position assurance (TPA). 6. Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) into the corresponding terminal release cavity. The release cavities are the 2 center rows of cavities on one half of the connector. Page 3413 3. Use a small flat-bladed tool to gently pry off the dress cover by inserting the tool under the cover opposite the harness side and prying up. 4. Remove the cover. 5. Using a small flat-bladed tool, push on the side of the nose piece retainer while pushing the nose piece forward with your thumb. This will release the terminal position assurance (TPA). 6. Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) into the corresponding terminal release cavity. The release cavities are the 2 center rows of cavities on one half of the connector. Engine - MIL ON P0116/P1400 Set In Very Cold Temps Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - MIL ON P0116/P1400 Set In Very Cold Temps TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 10-06-04-008A Date: January 24, 2011 Subject: Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) Illuminated at Very Cold Ambient Temperatures When Using Engine Coolant Heater, DTC P0116 and/or P1400 Set (Relocate Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor and Engine Coolant Heater Cord) Models: 2006-2007 Buick Rainier 2009 Buick LaCrosse Super, Allure Super (Canada Only) 2006-2010 Cadillac Escalade 2006-2007 Chevrolet Monte Carlo 2006-2009 Chevrolet Impala SS, TrailBlazer 2006-2010 Chevrolet Avalanche, Express, Silverado Tahoe 2006-2009 GMC Envoy 2006-2010 GMC Savana, Sierra, Yukon 2006-2008 Pontiac Grand Prix 2006-2009 Saab 9-7X Equipped with V8 Engine RPO LC9, LH6, LH8, LH9, L76, LS2, LS4, LFA, LZ1, L92, L94, L9H or L20, L96, LMF, LMG, LY2, LY5, LY6 Please Refer to GMVIS Attention: To properly correct this condition, you must follow both of the procedures to relocate the ECT sensor and the engine coolant heater cord. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add cast iron block engine RPOs and to update the Warranty Information coverage period. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 10-06-04-008 (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). Condition Some customers may comment that the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) illuminates after starting the vehicle when they were using the engine coolant heater in very cold ambient temperatures. This usually occurs in a range of -23 to -40°C (-10 to -40°F) or colder. The technician may observe on a scan tool DTC P0116 and/or P1400 set as Current or in History. Cause This condition may be caused by the engine control module (ECM) determining that the ignition OFF time requirement has been met at start-up and interpreting the temperature difference between the engine coolant temperature (ECT) sensor and the intake air temperature (IAT) sensor as being outside of a calibrated range. Correction Important DO NOT replace the ECM for this condition. Relocating the ECT Sensor 1. Turn ON the ignition with the engine OFF. 2. Perform the diagnostic system check - vehicle. Refer to Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle in SI. ‹› If DTC P0116 and/or P1400 are set and the customer WAS using the engine coolant heater, proceed to Step 3. ‹› If DTC P0116 and/or P1400 are set and the customer WAS NOT using the engine coolant heater, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle in SI. 3. Turn OFF the ignition. Warning To avoid being burned, do not remove the radiator cap or surge tank cap while the engine is hot. The cooling system will release scalding fluid and steam Page 8004 11. Insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) into the 2 triangular cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 12. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE 1. Prior to installation the terminal must be aligned so the (1) coding lugs align with the (2) coding grooves on the connector. 2. Once the terminal is aligned, slide the terminal into the cavity until the retainer has engaged in the cavity of the connector. 3. Slide the TPA in the connector body and seat it using a small flat bladed tool. The TPA is seated when it is flush with the contact housing. 4. Secure the wires to the connector body using a tie wrap and replace the dress cover and grommet. Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) BOSCH CONNECTORS (2.8 JPT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Pull out the slider on the connector position assurance (CPA) until it is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 2439 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (BSK) BOSCH CONNECTORS (BSK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 3. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 4. Insert the J 38125-561 tool into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 5. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is Page 6027 6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias. Reference the appropriate service manual wiring schematic to obtain the correct diode installation position. 7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for the soldering equipment. 8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed. 9. IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode attachment points with tape. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape. Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable SPLICING TWISTED OR SHIELDED CABLE Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable. 1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splice is made. 3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire. Staggering the splices by 65 mm (2.5 in) is recommended. 4. IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical contact with the drain wire. Re-assemble the cable. Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape. - Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1). - Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire. - Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape. Page 5195 REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. The release tab is located on the top of the wiredress cover. View of connector in released position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Page 6182 Utility/Van Zoning UTILITY/VAN ZONING Page 954 1. Squeeze the negative battery cable together. Important: Ensure the generator battery current sensor is installed in the correct direction and location on the negative battery cable. 2. Slide the NEW generator battery current sensor (1) up onto the negative battery cable and insert the tab under the negative battery cable terminal cover. 3. Wrap electrical tape around the generator battery current sensor leg in order to secure the sensor to the negative battery cable. 4. Install the negative battery cable clips to the cable to the locations previously marked during removal. 5. Install the negative battery cable. Page 2082 Page 8894 IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals. Front probe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the connector. IMPORTANT: When probing female 0.64 terminals, it is important to use the correct adapter. There have been some revisions to the test adapter for 0.64 terminals. The proper adapter for 0.64 terminals is the J 35616-64B which has a gold terminal and a black wire between the base and tip. Failure to use the proper test adapter may result in damage to the terminal being tested and improper diagnosis. NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Page 6904 Depress the locks that are located on both sides of the wiredress cover and pull the lever over and past the locks. View of the connector when released from the component. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the front of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool push down on one of the locking tabs and pull the cover up until the dress cover releases. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. Page 8182 7. The illustration above identifies the entry canal where the terminal release tool will be inserted, and the terminal cavity. - Terminal (1) - Entry Canal (2) 8. Insert the J-38125-553 (15315247) tool into the entry canal and pry up on the terminal retainer. The terminal retainer is a small plastic piece on the top of the terminal. The terminal retainer must be held up while the terminal is pulled out of the connector. Page 8029 4. Use a small flat-blade tool to slide the terminal position assurance (TPA) up one notch on both ends of the connector. The TPA is located underneath the wire dress cover. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 1634 Release the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the blue locking tabs on both ends of the connector. Gently slide the TPA up to the released position on both ends. 6. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-13A (GM P/N 12031876-1) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. Page 8159 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Ensure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the Terminal Removal Procedure. Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PULL TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL If the terminal is visibly damaged or is suspected of having a faulty connection, the terminal should be replaced. Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors: 1. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) device and/or the secondary lock. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component or separate the connectors for in-line connectors. 3. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device. 4. Insert the proper pick or removal tool into the front of the connector body. 5. IMPORTANT: On connectors with more than one terminal the service loop may not be large enough to remove the terminal and crimp on a new one. If the terminal wire does not have a large enough service loop for removal, cut the wire 5 cm (2 in) behind the connector before removal. Grasp the wire at the back of the connector body and gently push the terminal out the front of the connector body. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. If the wire needed to be cut in order to remove the terminal, gently push a small length of the same size wire through the back of the connector cavity until there is enough wire exposed in order to crimp on a new terminal. If the wire was not cut, cut the existing wire as close to the old terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 4. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. TERMINAL INSTALLATION 1. Align the terminal and pull the wire from the back of the connector in order to seat the terminal. 2. If necessary, cut the new wire to proper length and splice with existing circuit. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. 3. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply dielectric grease to the connector. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PUSH TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 2805 Power Window Switch: Diagrams Window Switch - LR Page 6313 Release the tabs that are holding the wiredress cover to the connector body. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the slots on both ends of the connector body. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. J 38125-216 can also be used to remove the nose piece. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by lifting the terminal retaining tabs on the inside of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 5806 It is very important to use the correct test adapter when testing for proper terminal contact of fuses and relays in a bussed electrical center (BEC). Use J-35616-35 to test for proper terminal contact. Failure to use J-35616-35 can result in improper diagnosis of the BEC. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Separate the connector halves. 2. Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body. 3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J-38125 , test that the retention force is significantly different between a good terminal and a suspect terminal. Replace the female terminal in question. FLAT WIRE (DOCK AND LOCK) CONNECTORS There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock) connectors on the harness side or the component side. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Remove the component in question. 2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side of the connector as oil from your skin may be a source of contamination as well. 3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other imperfections that could cause poor terminal contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are uniform and free of damage or deformation. 4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the on the flat wire harness connector in order to test the circuit in question. CONTROL MODULE/COMPONENT VOLTAGE AND GROUNDS Poor voltage or ground connections can cause widely varying symptoms. Test all control module voltage supply circuits. Many vehicles have multiple circuits supplying voltage to a control module. Other components in the system may have separate voltage supply circuits that may also need to be tested. Inspect connections at the module/component connectors, fuses, and any intermediate connections between the voltage source and the module/component. A test lamp or a DMM may indicate that voltage is present, but neither tests the ability of the circuit to carry sufficient current. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Power Distribution Schematics. - Test all control module ground and system ground circuits. The control module may have multiple ground circuits. Other components in the system may have separate grounds that may also need to be tested. Inspect grounds for clean and tight connections at the grounding point. Inspect the connections at the component and in splice packs, where applicable. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Ground Distribution Schematics. TEMPERATURE SENSITIVITY - An intermittent condition may occur when a component/connection reaches normal operating temperature. The condition may occur only when the component/connection is cold, or only when the component/connection is hot. - Freeze Frame, Failure Records, Snapshot, or Vehicle Data Recorder data may help with this type of intermittent condition, where applicable. - If the intermittent is related to heat, review the data for a relationship with the following: High ambient temperatures - Underhood/engine generated heat - Circuit generated heat due to a poor connection, or high electrical load - Higher than normal load conditions, towing, etc. - If the intermittent is related to cold, review the data for the following: Low ambient temperatures-In extremely low temperatures, ice may form in a connection or component. Inspect for water intrusion. - The condition only occurs on a cold start. - The condition goes away when the vehicle warms up. - Information from the customer may help to determine if the trouble follows a pattern that is temperature related. - If temperature is suspected of causing an intermittent fault condition, attempt to duplicate the condition. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required. ELECTROMAGNETIC INTERFERENCE (EMI) AND ELECTRICAL NOISE Some electrical components/circuits are sensitive to electromagnetic interference (EMI) or other types of electrical noise. Inspect for the following conditions: A misrouted harness that is too close to high voltage/high current devices such as secondary ignition components, motors, generator etc-These components may induce electrical noise on a circuit that could interfere with normal circuit operation. - Electrical system interference caused by a malfunctioning relay, or a control module driven solenoid or switch-These conditions can cause a sharp electrical surge. Normally, the condition will occur when the malfunctioning component is operating. - Improper installation of non-factory or aftermarket add on accessories such as lights, 2-way radios, amplifiers, electric motors, remote starters, alarm systems, cell phones, etc-These accessories may lead to interference while in use, but do not fail when the accessories are not in use. - Test for an open diode across the A/C compressor clutch and for other open diodes. Some relays may contain a clamping diode. - The generator may be allowing AC noise into the electrical system. INCORRECT CONTROL MODULE - There are only a few situations where reprogramming a control module is appropriate: A new service control module is installed. Page 1575 3. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. View showing depressing of the lever lock release tab. Page 6111 2. Locate the two indents of the terminal position assurance (TPA) located on the bottom of the connector body. Page 8565 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. 4. Remove the dress cover by using a flat bladed tool to release the dress cover locking tabs and lift up on the dress cover. 5. Cut the tie wrap that holds the wires to the connector body. Page 5970 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert terminal into the appropriate terminal holder until it hits bottom and stops. The correct terminal holder is determined by the wire size. Also ensure that the terminals wings are pointing towards the former on the tool and the release locator. 5. Insert the stripped cable into the terminal. Insulation should be visible on both sides of the terminal insulation wings. 6. Compress the handles until the ratchet automatically releases. 7. Place the terminal into the appropriate cavity and assemble the connector. Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO-PACK 100W) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W connectors. These connectors are very similar but use different terminals and have some minor physical differences also. Page 1887 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully raise the TPA on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA cannot be removed from the connector while there are terminals present in the connector body. View of the TPA when removed from the connector body. 4. Use the J 38125-12A tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the left side of the terminal release cavity as shown in the graphic. Use the tool to move the terminal release to the right with a gentle prying motion. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Engine - Valve Lifter Tick Noise At Start Up Oil Filter: Customer Interest Engine - Valve Lifter Tick Noise At Start Up TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 10-06-01-007C Date: February 09, 2011 Subject: Active Fuel Management (AFM) Engine, Valve Lifter Tick Noise at Start Up When Engine Has Been Off for 2 Hours or More (Evaluate Noise and/or Replace Valve Lifters) Models: 2007 Buick Rainier 2009 Buick LaCrosse Super, Allure Super (Canada Only) 2007 Cadillac Escalade Built Prior to April 1, 2006 with 6.2L Engine RPO L92 (These engines were built with AFM Hardware but the AFM system was disabled) 2010-2011 Cadillac Escalade, Escalade ESV, Escalade EXT 2007 Chevrolet Monte Carlo 2007-2009 Chevrolet Impala 2007-2011 Chevrolet Avalanche, Silverado, Suburban, Tahoe, TrailBlazer, TrailBlazer EXT 2010-2011 Chevrolet Camaro SS 2007-2011 GMC Envoy, Envoy XL, Sierra, Yukon, Yukon Denali, Yukon XL, Yukon XL Denali 2007-2008 Pontiac Grand Prix 2008-2009 Pontiac G8 2007-2009 Saab 9-7X Equipped with AFM (Active Fuel Management) and V8 Engine RPO L76, L94, L99, LC9, LFA, LH6, LMG, LS4, LY5 or LZ1 Attention: This bulletin only applies to the AFM V8 engines listed above. It DOES NOT apply to Non-AFM Engines. If you are dealing with a Non-AFM engine that is experiencing a similar noise, please refer to Engine Mechanical > Diagnostic Information and Procedures > Symptoms in SI. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add models. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 10-06-01-007B (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). Condition Some customers may comment on an engine valve lifter tick noise that occurs after the engine has been shut off for at least two hours. The tick noise may last from two seconds to ten minutes. Cause This condition may be caused by any of the following: - Aerated oil in the valve lifter body, resulting in the valve lifter being unable to purge the air quickly. - A low engine oil level or incorrect oil viscosity. - Dirty or contaminated oil. - A low internal valve lifter oil reservoir level. - Debris in the valve lifter. - A high valve lifter leak down rate. Correction If the SI diagnostics do not isolate the cause of this valve lifter tick noise and normal oil pressure is noted during the concern, perform the following steps: 1. Inspect the engine oil condition and level. Refer to Owner Manual > Service and Appearance Care > Checking Things Under the Hood > Description and Operation > Engine Oil in SI. ‹› If the engine oil is more than one quart low, an incorrect oil viscosity is being used or if poor quality/contamination is observed, change the oil and filter. Note Locations Starter Relay: Locations Fuse Block - Underhood (5.3L/6.0L), Label Page 5578 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. 4. Remove the dress cover by using a flat bladed tool to release the dress cover locking tabs and lift up on the dress cover. 5. Cut the tie wrap that holds the wires to the connector body. Page 5983 4. Use a small flat-blade tool to slide the terminal position assurance (TPA) up one notch on both ends of the connector. The TPA is located underneath the wire dress cover. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 1461 pulling it through. This will prevent damage to the internal seals of the connector. Once the terminal is pushed out of the connector, cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible and pull the wire through the connector. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE The Micro-Pack 100W connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool was developed to crimp Micro-Pack 100W terminals. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 2. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert the terminal into the crimp tool until the core wings are flush with the anvil on the crimp tool. Be sure that the wings are pointed toward the crimp tool former and release the spring locator. The locator will hold the terminal in place. Inspect the alignment of the terminal wings with the crimp tool former. If the terminal wings are wider than the crimp tool former, remove the terminal and bend the terminal wings in slightly. 5. Place stripped wire into terminal. 6. Crimp the new terminal to the wire. If a jam occurs, press the emergency release to open applicator. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire perform the following procedure in order to replace Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. Page 4375 Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested: - Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. - Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a component or to other harnesses. - If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A TEST LAMP TOOLS REQUIRED J 35616-200 Test Light - Probe Kit NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminate even though voltage is present. The J 35616-200 is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair of leads. To properly operate this tool use the following procedures. When testing for voltage: 1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested. When testing for ground: 1. Attach one lead to battery positive voltage. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where ground should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is ground at the point being tested. Using Connector Test Adapters USING CONNECTOR TEST ADAPTERS NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Using Fused Jumper Wires USING FUSED JUMPER WIRES TOOLS REQUIRED J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged. The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested. AFL/ECP Connectors AFL/EPC CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 7132 Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Service and Repair Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure Notice: Use care when handling the coolant sensor. Damage to the coolant sensor will affect the operation of the fuel control system. 1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Raise and suitably support the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 3. Drain the cooling system below the level of the ECT sensor. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System (LL8) Draining and Filling Cooling System (LH6, LS2). 4. Lower the vehicle. 5. Disconnect the engine coolant temperature (ECT) sensor electrical connector (1). 6. Remove the ECT sensor. Installation Procedure Notice: Replacement components must be the correct part number for the application. Components requiring the use of the thread locking compound, lubricants, corrosion inhibitors, or sealants are identified in the service procedure. Some replacement components may come with these coatings already applied. Do not use these coatings on components unless specified. These coatings can affect the final torque, which may affect the operation of the component. Use the correct torque specification when installing components in order to avoid damage. Notice: Use care when handling the coolant sensor. Damage to the coolant sensor will affect the operation of the fuel control system. 1. Coat the ECT sensor threads with sealer GM P/N 12346004 (Canadian P/N 10953480), or equivalent. Page 6352 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the rear TPA from the connector. 7. IMPORTANT: The front TPA cannot be removed from the connector. Only move it to the release point. Use a small flat-blade tool to move the front TPA to the release position. 8. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 9. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Molex Connectors Page 4617 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert terminal into the appropriate terminal holder until it hits bottom and stops. The correct terminal holder is determined by the wire size. Also ensure that the terminals wings are pointing towards the former on the tool and the release locator. 5. Insert the stripped cable into the terminal. Insulation should be visible on both sides of the terminal insulation wings. 6. Compress the handles until the ratchet automatically releases. 7. Place the terminal into the appropriate cavity and assemble the connector. Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO-PACK 100W) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W connectors. These connectors are very similar but use different terminals and have some minor physical differences also. Page 3334 Fuse Block - Rear, Label Usage Page 2540 Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair Key and Lock Cylinder Coding Use Instruction Sheet Supplied For the lock cylinder coding procedure, refer to the instruction sheet supplied in the lock cylinder kit. For key cutting information, refer to the instructions provided from the manufacturer of the key cutting equipment used. Page 1907 2. Use a small flat-bladed tool to release the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting the tool in the small recess on the side of the connector and pushing up until the TPA releases from the connector body. The TPA should raise just slightly. Do not try to remove the TPA. IMPORTANT: The TPA on this connector cannot be removed unless the terminals are removed first. The TPA will come out of the connector body, but only slightly. When the TPA is slightly raised the terminals can be removed. Using excessive force to remove the TPA with the terminals still in the connector will damage the connector. 3. Repeat the process for the other side of the connector. 4. Ensure that the TPA is in the proper position to remove the terminals. Page 8422 2. Locate the two indents of the terminal position assurance (TPA) located on the bottom of the connector body. Tire Pressure Monitor - TPM System Message/Service Tips Low Tire Pressure Indicator: Technical Service Bulletins Tire Pressure Monitor - TPM System Message/Service Tips # 09-03-16-002A: Dealership Service Consultant Procedure as Vehicle Comes into Service Drive for Tire Pressure Monitor (TPM) System Message, Light and Customer Information - (Apr 27, 2010) Subject: Dealership Service Consultant Procedure as Vehicle Comes into Service Drive for Tire Pressure Monitor (TPM) System Message, Light and Customer Information Models: 2006-2011 Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Including Saturn and Saab) 2006-2010 HUMMER H2, H3 ATTENTION The information found in this bulletin is to be used as a dealership service consultant procedures for customers coming into the service lane with an illuminated "low tire light" or comments on a check tire pressure/low tire pressure/add air to tire or service tire monitor system message. Maintaining proper tire pressures is an Owner's Maintenance item and is not covered under warranty. This bulletin is being revised to add model years and update additional bulletin reference information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 09-03-16-002 (Section 03 -- Suspension). Customer Concerns and Confusion with the Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) System The following procedure should be used by dealership service consultants when a customer comes into the service drive with a "low tire light" on or comments on a check tire pressure/low tire pressure/add air to tire or service tire monitor system message. The service consultant should perform the following steps: Procedure Turn the key to ON, without starting the engine. ^ If the low tire light comes on and stays on solid with a check tire pressure/low tire pressure/add air to tire message (on vehicles equipped with DIC), advise the customer: - The system is working properly. - Properly adjusting all tire air pressures to the recommended levels and driving the vehicle will turn the light off (refer to the Tire and Loading Information label on the driver side door). - More detailed information can be found in the Owner Manual. - Service is not covered under warranty - this maintenance is the responsibility of the owner. - Give the customer a copy of the "GM Customer TPMS Information". ^ If the Tire Pressure Monitor (TPM) light blinks for one minute then stays on solid with a service tire monitor system message (on vehicles equipped with DIC): - A TPM system problem exists. The vehicle should be written up accordingly and sent to your service department for further DTC diagnosis and service. - If dashes (--) are displayed in only one or two of the tire pressure readouts, it is likely caused by a previous TPM system relearn that was performed incorrectly due to interference from another vehicle's TPM system during the relearn process (refer to the Important statement later in this bulletin regarding TPM relearn with a Tech 2(R)). - If dashes (--) are displayed in all four of the tire pressure readouts, there is a system problem. Follow the appropriate SI service procedures. ^ If a customer indicates the low tire light comes on for a few minutes when the vehicle is started, then goes off after driving a while, advise the customer: - The system is working properly. - Most likely, air pressure in one or more of the tires is low enough to turn the light on when tires are cold. After driving for a while, tires will heat Page 5598 2. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully push the terminal position assurance (TPA) towards the face of the connector on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA is fragile and may break if not done carefully. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. 3. Use the J 38125-215 tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 5436 - Most Molex connectors will have the Molex logo on the dresscover of the connector. In some cases the connectors may have MX followed by another letter. The third letter indicates where the connector was made. A connector with MXD is a Molex connector made in Detroit. Sumitomo has a unique symbol on their connector and possibly a part number. The symbol is similar to that of a diamond lying on its side, similar to that shown. The logo could appear anywhere but the most common place is at the wire side of the housing. Tyco/AMP has many different and unique connector designs. Some may or may not have identifiable marks on them. Page 4978 US English/Metric Conversion US English/Metric Conversion Page 5033 4. Install the right exhaust manifold pipe nuts. Ensure the catalytic converter is held in the installed position before tightening the nuts. Tighten the nuts to 50 N.m (37 lb ft). 5. Install the left exhaust manifold pipe nuts. Tighten the nuts to 50 N.m (37 lb ft). 6. Install the transmission support. Refer to Transmission Support Replacement. 7. Remove the transmission jack. 8. If equipped with 4WD, install the front propeller shaft. Refer to Front Propeller Shaft Replacement. 9. Install the rear propeller shaft. Refer to Rear Propeller Shaft Replacement. Important: A special anti-seize compound is used on the HO2S threads. The compound consists of liquid graphite and glass beads. The graphite tends to burn away, but the glass beads remain, making the sensor easier to remove. New, or service replacement sensors already have the compound applied to the threads. If the sensor is removed from an exhaust component and if for any reason the sensor is to be reinstalled, the threads must have anti-seize compound applied before the reinstallation. 10. If reinstalling the old sensors, coat the threads with anti-seize compound GM P/N 12377953, or equivalent. Page 3758 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the TPA. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the nose piece. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. Page 2717 Remove all rust from the ground terminal, the cylinder head and the retaining nut or bolt. Position the main engine wiring harness ground terminal and install the nut or bolt. Tighten: Tighten the retaining nut or bolt to 16 N.m (12 lb ft). Apply some type of electrical moisture sealant to protect the harness terminal from further corrosion. Disclaimer Page 6335 7. Apply pressure and gently rock the cover until one locking leg is unseated. 8. Continue to apply pressure and rock the cover until the second locking leg is unseated. Repeat procedure for the other side of the dress cover and remove the cover. 9. Use J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) to gently lift the terminal retaining tab while gently pulling the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 10. If the terminal is severely bent or damaged, it may be possible on some connectors to push the wire out of the front of the connector instead of Page 6013 View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. 4. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers CIRCUIT PROTECTION - CIRCUIT BREAKERS A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types of circuit Page 7755 Refer to the following table as a guide in selecting the correct test adapter for front probing connectors: Backprobe IMPORTANT: Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures. - Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector. - Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large of a test probe. - After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected, test for proper terminal contact. Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the connector. Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure SCAN TOOL SNAPSHOT PROCEDURE Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used Page 6311 3. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. View showing depressing of the lever lock release tab. Page 4533 3. Remove the dress cover by using a flat-blade tool to release the connector locking tabs and pulling off the dress cover. 4. Relieve the tension on the nose piece retainers by inserting J-38125-12A (12094429) into the single retainer slot on the end of the nose piece and gently prying out the locking tab. Repeat the process for both of the nose piece locking tabs on the opposite side of the nose piece. Page 3394 Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. FCI Connectors FCI CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 6622 Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Crankshaft Position System Variation Learn Crankshaft Position System Variation Learn 1. Install a scan tool. 2. Monitor the engine control module (ECM) for DTCs with a scan tool. If other DTCs are set, except DTC P0315, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle in Vehicle DTC Information for the applicable DTC that set. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Descriptions 3. Select the crankshaft position (CKP) variation learn procedure with a scan tool. 4. The scan tool instructs you to perform the following: 1. Accelerate to wide open throttle (WOT). 2. Release throttle when fuel cut-off occurs. 3. Observe fuel cut-off for applicable engine. 4. Engine should not accelerate beyond calibrated RPM value. 5. Release throttle immediately if value is exceeded. 6. Block drive wheels. 7. Set parking brake. 8. DO NOT apply brake pedal. 9. Cycle ignition from OFF to ON. 10. Apply and hold brake pedal. 11. Start and idle engine. 12. Turn A/C OFF. 13. Vehicle must remain in Park or Neutral. 14. The scan tool monitors certain component signals to determine if all the conditions are met to continue with the procedure. The scan tool only displays the condition that inhibits the procedure. The scan tool monitors the following components: * CKP sensors activity-If there is a CKP sensor condition, refer to the applicable DTC that set. * Camshaft position (CMP) sensor activity-If there is a CMP sensor condition, refer to the applicable DTC that set. * Engine coolant temperature (ECT)-If the ECT is not warm enough, idle the engine until the engine coolant temperature reaches the correct temperature. 5. Enable the CKP system variation learn procedure with a scan tool. Important: While the learn procedure is in progress, release the throttle immediately when the engine starts to decelerate. The engine control is returned to the operator and the engine responds to throttle position after the learn procedure is complete. 6. Accelerate to WOT. 7. Release when the fuel cut-off occurs. 8. Test in progress 9. The scan tool displays Learn Status: Learned this ignition. If the scan tool indicates that DTC P0315 ran and passed, the CKP variation learn procedure is complete. If the scan tool indicates DTC P0315 failed or did not run, refer to DTC P0315. If any other DTCs set, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle in Vehicle DTC Information for the applicable DTC that set. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Descriptions See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/P Code Charts/P0315 10. Turn OFF the ignition for 30 seconds after the learn procedure is completed successfully. 11. The CKP system variation learn procedure is also required when the following service procedures have been performed, regardless of whether DTC P0315 is set: * A CKP sensor replacement * An engine replacement * A ECM replacement * A harmonic balancer replacement * A crankshaft replacement * Any engine repairs which disturb the CKP sensor relationship Page 2556 Page 5297 Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. For connectors with a bolt in the dress cover, turn the bolt counterclockwise to remove the connector from the component. 2. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. A/T - DEXRON(R)-VI Fluid Information Fluid - A/T: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - DEXRON(R)-VI Fluid Information INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-037E Date: April 07, 2011 Subject: Release of DEXRON(R)-VI Automatic Transmission Fluid (ATF) Models: 2008 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2003-2008 HUMMER H2 2006-2008 HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saturn Relay 2005 and Prior Saturn L-Series 2005-2007 Saturn ION 2005-2008 Saturn VUE with 4T45-E 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X Except 2008 and Prior Chevrolet Aveo, Equinox Except 2006 and Prior Chevrolet Epica Except 2007 and Prior Chevrolet Optra Except 2008 and Prior Pontiac Torrent, Vibe, Wave Except 2003-2005 Saturn ION with CVT or AF23 Only Except 1991-2002 Saturn S-Series Except 2008 and Prior Saturn VUE with CVT, AF33 or 5AT (MJ7/MJ8) Transmission Only Except 2008 Saturn Astra Attention: DEXRON(R)-VI Automatic Transmission Fluid (ATF) is the only approved fluid for warranty repairs for General Motors transmissions/transaxles requiring DEXRON(R)-III and/or prior DEXRON(R) transmission fluids. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 04-07-30-037D (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle). MANUAL TRANSMISSIONS / TRANSFER CASES and POWER STEERING The content of this bulletin does not apply to manual transmissions or transfer cases. Any vehicle that previously required DEXRON(R)-III for a manual transmission or transfer case should now use P/N 88861800. This fluid is labeled Manual Transmission and Transfer Case Fluid. Some manual transmissions and transfer cases require a different fluid. Appropriate references should be checked when servicing any of these components. Power Steering Systems should now use P/N 9985010 labeled Power Steering Fluid. Consult the Parts Catalog, Owner's Manual, or Service Information (SI) for fluid recommendations. Some of our customers and/or General Motors dealerships/Saturn Retailers may have some concerns with DEXRON(R)-VI and DEXRON(R)-III Automatic Transmission Fluid (ATF) and transmission warranty claims. DEXRON(R)-VI is the only approved fluid for warranty repairs for General Motors transmissions/transaxles requiring DEXRON(R)-III and/or prior DEXRON(R) transmission fluids (except as noted above). Please remember that the clean oil reservoirs of the J-45096 - Flushing and Flow Tester machine should be purged of DEXRON(R)-III and filled with DEXRON(R)-VI for testing, flushing or filling General Motors transmissions/transaxles (except as noted above). DEXRON(R)-VI can be used in any proportion in past model vehicles equipped with an automatic transmission/transaxle in place of DEXRON(R)-III (i.e. topping off the fluid in the event of a repair or fluid change). DEXRON(R)-VI is also compatible with any former version of DEXRON(R) for use in automatic transmissions/transaxles. DEXRON(R)-VI ATF General Motors Powertrain has upgraded to DEXRON(R)-VI ATF with the start of 2006 vehicle production. Current and prior automatic transmission models that had used DEXRON(R)-III must now only use DEXRON(R)-VI. Page 5700 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Ensure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the Terminal Removal Procedure. Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PULL TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL If the terminal is visibly damaged or is suspected of having a faulty connection, the terminal should be replaced. Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors: 1. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) device and/or the secondary lock. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component or separate the connectors for in-line connectors. 3. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device. 4. Insert the proper pick or removal tool into the front of the connector body. 5. IMPORTANT: On connectors with more than one terminal the service loop may not be large enough to remove the terminal and crimp on a new one. If the terminal wire does not have a large enough service loop for removal, cut the wire 5 cm (2 in) behind the connector before removal. Grasp the wire at the back of the connector body and gently push the terminal out the front of the connector body. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. If the wire needed to be cut in order to remove the terminal, gently push a small length of the same size wire through the back of the connector cavity until there is enough wire exposed in order to crimp on a new terminal. If the wire was not cut, cut the existing wire as close to the old terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 4. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. TERMINAL INSTALLATION 1. Align the terminal and pull the wire from the back of the connector in order to seat the terminal. 2. If necessary, cut the new wire to proper length and splice with existing circuit. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. 3. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply dielectric grease to the connector. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PUSH TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 7831 The engine harness may be repaired using the J-38125. High Temperature Wiring Repairs HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperatures, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time may use materials i.e. wires, connectors, and shielding that has a higher heat rating than typical wiring. When making a repair in a high temperature area observe the following: Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature to replace any damaged wire. - Replace any heat shielding that is removed. - Cover any DuraSeal splice sleeves with SCT1 shrink tubing (available in the J-38125 Terminal Repair kit). - After making a wiring repair, ensure that the location of the wiring is not moved closer to the heat source. IDENTIFYING HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperature, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time need special considerations when making wiring repairs. Areas that may be exposed to higher temperatures can be identified by heat resistant materials that are being used in those areas. These materials may include heat reflective tape, moon tape, and high temperature shrink tubing. Also conduit and other protective coverings may be used. Because conduit or similar coverings are used throughout the vehicle regardless of the temperature, it may be necessary for the technician to determine if an area is exposed to excessive heat before making a wiring repair. Obvious areas of consideration would be any area located near the exhaust manifolds, catalytic converter, and exhaust pipes. The J-38125 contains much of the material you will need to perform repairs on areas exposed to high heat. The kit contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves to crimp and seal connections - High temperature SCT1 shrink tubing to protect the splice sleeves - A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct crimp tool to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools to remove the terminals from the connectors The J-38125 does not contain wire that is suitable to high temperature exposure. Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature of the same or larger gage size as the original wire when repair damage wire. Also replace any reflective tape that you remove during the repair. HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature rating of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125 and then encapsulate the splice sleeve using the high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the order listed. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip keeping all of the wire strands intact. Page 2088 Checking Aftermarket Accessories CHECKING AFTERMARKET ACCESSORIES Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits: - CAUTION: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol. - NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice. OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol. Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the cause of the problems. Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include: Power feeds connected to points other than the battery - Antenna location - Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring - Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line - Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories. Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions INDUCING INTERMITTENT FAULT CONDITIONS TOOLS REQUIRED J 25070 Heat Gun Many intermittent open or shorted circuits are affected by harness/connector movement that is caused by vibration, engine torque, bumps/rough pavement, etc. In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness if the malfunction appears to be Tire Chain Usage Description Wheels: Description and Operation Tire Chain Usage Description Tire Chain Usage Description Tire Chain Usage Description When you use tire chains, most current vehicles require the following chain types: ^ SAE Class S or 1100 Series, Type PL tire chains (1) ^ SAE Class U or 1200 Series, Type P tire chains (2) ^ 1800 Series Lug Reinforced tire chains (3) These chains are specially designed in order to limit the fly-off effect that occurs when the wheel rotates. Manufacturers of tire chains have a specific chain size for each tire size. These ensure a proper fit when the chains are installed. Purchase the correct chains for the tires on which the chains will be used. Do not use rubber adjusters to take up slack in chains that are loose due to incorrect size. Always follow the chain manufacturer's installation instructions. The use of chains may adversely affect handling. When using chains, remember the following information: ^ Ensure that the vehicle is designed for chain clearance. ^ Adjust the speed to road conditions. ^ Avoid sharp turns. ^ Avoid locked-wheel braking in order to prevent chain damage to the vehicle. ^ Install the chains as tightly as possible on the drive tires. Tighten the chains again after driving 0.4-0.8 km (0.25-0.5 mi). Do not use chains on the non-drive tires. These chains may contact and damage the vehicle. If you use chains on the non-drive tires, ensure that there is enough clearance. ^ Do not exceed 70 km/h (45 mph). Do not exceed the chain manufacturer's speed limit, if lower. ^ Drive in a restrained manner. Avoid large bumps, potholes, severe turns, and other maneuvers that cause the tires to bounce up and down. ^ Follow any other instructions from the chain manufacturer that do not disagree with the above. Page 3969 Valve Cover: Service and Repair Valve Rocker Arm Cover Replacement - Right Side Valve Rocker Arm Cover Replacement - Right Side Removal Procedure 1. Remove the air conditioning (A/C) compressor hose. Refer to Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement (LH6, LS2) Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement (LL8). 2. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) lock. 3. Disconnect the main electrical connector (1) to the ignition coil wire harness. 4. Remove the harness clips. 5. Reposition the engine harness, if necessary. 6. Remove the spark plug wires from the ignition coils. ^ Twist each plug wire 1/2 turn. ^ Pull only on the boot in order to remove the wire from the ignition coil. Page 5008 Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Service and Repair Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure Notice: Use care when handling the coolant sensor. Damage to the coolant sensor will affect the operation of the fuel control system. 1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Raise and suitably support the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 3. Drain the cooling system below the level of the ECT sensor. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System (LL8) Draining and Filling Cooling System (LH6, LS2). 4. Lower the vehicle. 5. Disconnect the engine coolant temperature (ECT) sensor electrical connector (1). 6. Remove the ECT sensor. Installation Procedure Notice: Replacement components must be the correct part number for the application. Components requiring the use of the thread locking compound, lubricants, corrosion inhibitors, or sealants are identified in the service procedure. Some replacement components may come with these coatings already applied. Do not use these coatings on components unless specified. These coatings can affect the final torque, which may affect the operation of the component. Use the correct torque specification when installing components in order to avoid damage. Notice: Use care when handling the coolant sensor. Damage to the coolant sensor will affect the operation of the fuel control system. 1. Coat the ECT sensor threads with sealer GM P/N 12346004 (Canadian P/N 10953480), or equivalent. Page 6468 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 8873 Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Adjustments Park/Neutral Position Switch Adjustment Important: ^ The following procedure is for vehicles that have not had the switch removed or replaced. If the switch has been removed or replaced, refer to Park/Neutral Position Switch Replacement for the proper adjustment procedure. ^ Apply the parking brake. ^ The engine must start in the P (Park) or N (Neutral) positions only. ^ Check the switch for proper operation. If adjustment is required, proceed as follows: 1. Place the transmission range selector in the N (Neutral) position. 2. With an assistant in the drivers seat, raise the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 3. Loosen the park/neutral position switch mounting bolts. 4. With the vehicle in the N (Neutral) position, rotate the switch while the assistant attempts to start the engine. 5. Following a successful start, turn the engine OFF. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 6. Tighten the bolts securing the switch to the transmission. Tighten the bolts to 25 N.m (18 lb ft). 7. Lower the vehicle. 8. Check the switch for proper operation. The engine must start in the P (Park) or N (Neutral) positions only. 9. Replace the park/neutral position switch if proper operation can not be achieved. Refer to Park/Neutral Position Switch Replacement. Page 6022 If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the DuraSeal splice sleeves. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: - Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. - Do not use the crimp and DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 to crimp DuraSeal splice sleeve. In order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 5332 4. Use a small flat-blade tool to slide the terminal position assurance (TPA) up one notch on both ends of the connector. The TPA is located underneath the wire dress cover. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 6600 breakers are used. CIRCUIT BREAKER This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high current is removed. POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) CIRCUIT BREAKER This type greatly increases its resistance when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker will re-close within a second or 2. Circuit Protection - Fuses CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSES The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and examine the element in the fuse for an open (2). If not broken (1), also check for continuity using a DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one of equal current rating. Circuit Protection - Fusible Links CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSIBLE LINKS Page 6292 Page 1281 Important: The turn signal switch housing must be pressed firmly against the steering column tilt head in order for the screws from the turn signal and multifunction switch assembly screws to line up. 1. Slide the turn signal switch housing onto the steering column shaft assembly. 2. Install the turn signal and multifunction switch assembly. Refer to Turn Signal Multifunction Switch Replacement. 3. Install the ignition lock cylinder case. Refer to Ignition Lock Cylinder Case Replacement. 4. Install the steering wheel onto the column. Refer to Steering Wheel Replacement. 5. Enable the SIR system. Refer to SIR Disabling and Enabling. Page 4776 Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Page 6069 to analyze the data during the time a vehicle condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a trigger point that you have determined. Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2 snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a first-in, first-out basis. If a third snapshot is taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost. Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types: Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice - Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200 frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not lost if the Scan Tool is powered down. The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis. The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected values by plotting 3 parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful, especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC. Testing for a Short to Voltage TESTING FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4. Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt, there is a short to voltage in the circuit. Testing for Continuity TESTING FOR CONTINUITY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6. Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit. 7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity. With a Test Lamp IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits. 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6. If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity. Testing for Electrical Intermittents TESTING FOR ELECTRICAL INTERMITTENTS Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment. - Testing for Short to Ground - Testing for Continuity - Testing for a Short to Voltage Page 6688 4. Once the front 2 locks are unlocked, lift the front of the dress cover and pull it forward. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the small slot on the TPA and pushing down until the TPA releases. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to angle or rock the J 38125-21 tool when inserting it into the connector or the tool may break. Insert the J 38125-21 (GM P/N 15381651-2) tool into the round canal between the terminals cavities at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to repair Micro 64 connector terminals. The Micro 64 connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-64 (M jaw) was developed to crimp Micro 64 terminals. The J 38125-64 crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. The J 38125-64 crimping tool is also designed to crimp both the wire and the insulation at the same time. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro 64 terminals. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. 1. Cut the wire as close to the damaged terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. Page 5705 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the TPA. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the nose piece. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. Page 8322 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link). - The wire insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. 5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold them between thumb and forefinger. 7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place. - Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction. - Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip. 8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool closes.Ensure that no strands of wire are cut. 10. Crimp the splice on each end (2). Page 1725 - JST connectors have JST in small letters on their connectors, similar to that above. The location of the logo will vary with the connector size and style. - Kostel has an "LK" with a circle around it. These connector are usually used as a transmissions connection and are currently use on some Cadillac vehicles. Page 8001 5. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove TPA from the connector. 6. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Diagram Information and Instructions Radiator Cooling Fan Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions Electrical Symbols Page 8769 Page 5494 If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the DuraSeal splice sleeves. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: - Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. - Do not use the crimp and DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 to crimp DuraSeal splice sleeve. In order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 8600 6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias. Reference the appropriate service manual wiring schematic to obtain the correct diode installation position. 7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for the soldering equipment. 8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed. 9. IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode attachment points with tape. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape. Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable SPLICING TWISTED OR SHIELDED CABLE Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable. 1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splice is made. 3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire. Staggering the splices by 65 mm (2.5 in) is recommended. 4. IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical contact with the drain wire. Re-assemble the cable. Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape. - Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1). - Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire. - Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape. Page 5673 Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. For connectors with a bolt in the dress cover, turn the bolt counterclockwise to remove the connector from the component. 2. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. Page 1858 6. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs located on the opposite side of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover at the connector end and pry up. 7. Remove the dress cover. 8. Cut the tie wrap on the wire bundle. 9. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting a small flat-bladed tool into the small slot in the end of the slider and pushing on the TPA until it comes out of the connector. When the TPA exits the opposite side of the connector, gasp the TPA and pull it completely out of the connector. 10. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 5499 6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias. Reference the appropriate service manual wiring schematic to obtain the correct diode installation position. 7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for the soldering equipment. 8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed. 9. IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode attachment points with tape. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape. Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable SPLICING TWISTED OR SHIELDED CABLE Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable. 1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splice is made. 3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire. Staggering the splices by 65 mm (2.5 in) is recommended. 4. IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical contact with the drain wire. Re-assemble the cable. Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape. - Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1). - Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire. - Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape. Page 7775 - In some cases Delphi will actually be printed on the connector. If Delphi is not printed on the connector, look for PED. In both cases there is no specific orientation for Delphi or PED and they can appear anywhere on the connector. - FCI connectors may have the FCI logo on their connectors. The logo is the letters FCI with an "A" above it. - JAE connector have JAE in small letters on their connectors. Page 634 results from the alteration or modification of a vehicle using non-GM approved parts or accessories. Dealers should be especially cautious of accessory companies that claim the installation of their product will not void the factory warranty. Many times these companies have even given direction on how to quickly disassemble the accessory in an attempt to preclude the manufacturer from finding out that is has been installed. Any suspect repairs should be reviewed by the Fixed Operations Manager (FOM), and in Canada by the Warranty Manager (WM) for appropriate repair direction. If it is decided that a goodwill repair is to be made on the vehicle, even with the installation of such non-GM approved components, the customer is to be made aware of General Motors position on this issue and is to sign the appropriate goodwill documentation required by General Motors. It is imperative for dealers to understand that by installing such devices, they are jeopardizing not only the warranty coverage, but also the performance and reliability of the customer's vehicle. Disclaimer Page 6236 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Kostal Connectors KOSTAL CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 3675 Wheel Fastener: Service and Repair Rear Suspension Wheel Stud Replacement Tools Required J 43631 Ball Joint Separator Removal Procedure 1. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 2. Remove the tire and wheel. Refer to Tire and Wheel Removal and Installation. 3. Remove the rotor. Refer to Rear Brake Rotor Replacement. 4. Remove the wheel stud from the axle flange using the J 43631. Installation Procedure 1. Install the stud into the axle flange. 2. Install the 4 washers and the lug nut to the stud. 3. Tighten the lug nut in order to draw the stud into the flange until the stud fully seats. 4. Remove the lug nut and the washers. 5. Install the rotor. Refer to Rear Brake Rotor Replacement. 6. Install the tire and wheel. Refer to Tire and Wheel Removal and Installation. 7. Lower the vehicle. Door Lock and Side Window Switch Replacement - Driver Side Power Door Lock Switch: Service and Repair Door Lock and Side Window Switch Replacement Driver Side DOOR LOCK AND SIDE WINDOW SWITCH REPLACEMENT - DRIVER REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Lift up on the front edge of the switch panel in order to release the front retaining clip. 2. Lift up on the rear edge of the switch panel in order to release the 2 rear retaining clips. 3. If equipped, disconnect the electrical connectors from the driver door module (1). 4. If replacing only the driver door module, remove the module from the door trim panel. 5. Disconnect the remaining electrical connectors from the switch panel. 6. If replacing only the switch panel, retain the driver door module for transfer. 7. Remove the switch panel assembly from the vehicle INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 1. Install the driver door module (1) to the door trim panel. 2. Connect the electrical connector to the driver door module. 3. If replacing the switch panel, connect the remaining electrical connectors. 4. IMPORTANT: When replacing the driver door module, the set up procedure must be performed. If replacing the driver door module, program the driver door module. Refer to LINK and Personalization Description and Operation. 5. Install the switch panel to the door trim panel, ensuring the front and rear retaining clips are fully seated. Locations Information Bus: Locations Lower Left Of The I/P Page 5289 MEASURING FREQUENCY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal. IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM to autorange to an appropriate range. 1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency measured. Measuring Voltage MEASURING VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit. 1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods: - Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. - Turn ON the engine. - Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls. - Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested. 3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The DMM displays the voltage measured at that point. Measuring Voltage Drop MEASURING VOLTAGE DROP NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points. Probing Electrical Connectors PROBING ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS Page 6926 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the rear TPA from the connector. 7. IMPORTANT: The front TPA cannot be removed from the connector. Only move it to the release point. Use a small flat-blade tool to move the front TPA to the release position. 8. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 9. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Molex Connectors Page 1166 Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair Inside Air Temperature Sensor Assembly Replacement Removal Procedure Important: Recline the driver seat rearward to access the left center trim pillar. 1. Remove the upper portion of the left center trim pillar. 2. Disconnect the electrical connector. 3. Remove the retaining clips from the B pillar. 4. Remove the inside air temperature sensor assembly (1) from the B pillar. Installation Procedure 1. Connect the electrical connector to the inside air temperature sensor assembly (1). 2. Install the inside air temperature sensor assembly (1) to the B pillar. 3. Install the retaining clips to the B pillar. 4. Install the upper portion of the left center trim pillar. Engine - MIL ON P0116/P1400 Set In Very Cold Temps Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - MIL ON P0116/P1400 Set In Very Cold Temps TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 10-06-04-008A Date: January 24, 2011 Subject: Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) Illuminated at Very Cold Ambient Temperatures When Using Engine Coolant Heater, DTC P0116 and/or P1400 Set (Relocate Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor and Engine Coolant Heater Cord) Models: 2006-2007 Buick Rainier 2009 Buick LaCrosse Super, Allure Super (Canada Only) 2006-2010 Cadillac Escalade 2006-2007 Chevrolet Monte Carlo 2006-2009 Chevrolet Impala SS, TrailBlazer 2006-2010 Chevrolet Avalanche, Express, Silverado Tahoe 2006-2009 GMC Envoy 2006-2010 GMC Savana, Sierra, Yukon 2006-2008 Pontiac Grand Prix 2006-2009 Saab 9-7X Equipped with V8 Engine RPO LC9, LH6, LH8, LH9, L76, LS2, LS4, LFA, LZ1, L92, L94, L9H or L20, L96, LMF, LMG, LY2, LY5, LY6 Please Refer to GMVIS Attention: To properly correct this condition, you must follow both of the procedures to relocate the ECT sensor and the engine coolant heater cord. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add cast iron block engine RPOs and to update the Warranty Information coverage period. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 10-06-04-008 (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). Condition Some customers may comment that the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) illuminates after starting the vehicle when they were using the engine coolant heater in very cold ambient temperatures. This usually occurs in a range of -23 to -40°C (-10 to -40°F) or colder. The technician may observe on a scan tool DTC P0116 and/or P1400 set as Current or in History. Cause This condition may be caused by the engine control module (ECM) determining that the ignition OFF time requirement has been met at start-up and interpreting the temperature difference between the engine coolant temperature (ECT) sensor and the intake air temperature (IAT) sensor as being outside of a calibrated range. Correction Important DO NOT replace the ECM for this condition. Relocating the ECT Sensor 1. Turn ON the ignition with the engine OFF. 2. Perform the diagnostic system check - vehicle. Refer to Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle in SI. ‹› If DTC P0116 and/or P1400 are set and the customer WAS using the engine coolant heater, proceed to Step 3. ‹› If DTC P0116 and/or P1400 are set and the customer WAS NOT using the engine coolant heater, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle in SI. 3. Turn OFF the ignition. Warning To avoid being burned, do not remove the radiator cap or surge tank cap while the engine is hot. The cooling system will release scalding fluid and steam Page 2591 The first connector design of the Micro-Pack 100W (1) has a white connector interface that holds the terminals. The second design of the Micro-Pack 100W (2) has a gray interface to hold the terminals. Also, the first design has terminal cavities that are further apart (3 mm centerline) and offset from the other row of terminal cavities in the connector. The second design has terminals cavities that are closer together (2.54 mm centerline) and aligned vertically. One other way to identify the second design is the thin strip of material that runs along the outside of the cavities. IMPORTANT: There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W terminals which are very similar. Ensure that you have the correct terminal before crimping the new terminal to the wire. The first design connector uses the longer terminal (1) that has a raised area in front of the recess in the terminal. The second design connector uses the shorter terminal without the raised area. Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro-Pack 100W connectors. Some Micro-Pack 100W connector disassembly procedures will vary. Use this procedure as a guide. 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 3717 vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide variety of actions, including: - Wiggling the harness - Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting - Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector - Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation - Relocating a harness or wires All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. Another option is, with the component commanded ON and OFF by the scan tool, move related connectors and wiring and observe the component operation. With the engine running, move related connectors and wiring while monitoring engine operation. If harness or connector movement affects the data displayed, component/system operation, or engine operation, inspect and repair the harness/connections as necessary. You may need to load the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these cases you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide good results as well. There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions, along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the circuit to these kinds of conditions. SALT WATER SPRAY Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture. Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5 percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously. HIGH TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070. Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault condition. The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis. This option does not allow for the same control, however. LOW TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect. If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to -18°C (0°F) from one end and +71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized cooling needs. Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or components in an effort to duplicate the concern. DUPLICATING FAILURE CONDITIONS - If none of the previous tests are successful, attempt to duplicate and/or capture the failure conditions. Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, where applicable, contains the conditions that were present when the DTC set. 1. Review and record Freeze Frame/Failure Records data. 2. Clear the DTCs using the scan tool. 3. Turn the key to OFF and wait 15 seconds. 4. Operate the vehicle under the same conditions that were noted in Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, as closely as possible. The vehicle must also be operating within the Conditions for Running the DTC. Refer to Conditions for Running the DTC in the supporting text if a DTC is being diagnosed. 5. Monitor DTC Status for the DTC being tested. The scan tool will indicate Ran, when the enabling conditions have been satisfied long enough for the DTC to run. The scan tool will also indicate whether the DTC passed or failed. - An alternate method is to drive the vehicle with the DMM connected to a suspected circuit. An abnormal reading on the DMM when the concern occurs, may help you locate the concern. Measuring Frequency Page 1078 Sunroof / Moonroof Switch: Service and Repair SUNROOF SWITCH REPLACEMENT REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Remove the overhead console in order to access the sunroof switch. 2. Disconnect the electrical connector from the sunroof switch. 3. With a flat bladed tool carefully release the tabs that retain the sunroof switch to the overhead console. 4. Remove the sunroof switch from the overhead console. INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 1. Position the sunroof switch alignment tabs to the slots in the console. 2. Install the sunroof switch into the console, ensuring that the retaining tabs are fully seated. 3. Connect the electrical connector to the sunroof switch. 4. Install the overhead console to the roof. Page 7669 4. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the rear of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. 5. Once the locking tabs are unlocked, slide the inner connector out of the rear of the connector housing. Page 1339 View of a typical Micro 64 connector. Depress the lock and pull the lever over and past the lock. Page 1610 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. JST Connectors JST CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, remove the connector from the component. Locations Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Locations Engine Controls Component Views Fuel Tank 1 - Fuel Tank Pressue (FTP) Sensor 2 - Fuel Pump and Sender Assembly 3 - Chassis Harness 4 Fuel Tank 5 - Evaporative Emission (EVAP) Canister Vent Solenoid Page 3354 IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals. Front probe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the connector. IMPORTANT: When probing female 0.64 terminals, it is important to use the correct adapter. There have been some revisions to the test adapter for 0.64 terminals. The proper adapter for 0.64 terminals is the J 35616-64B which has a gold terminal and a black wire between the base and tip. Failure to use the proper test adapter may result in damage to the terminal being tested and improper diagnosis. NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Page 4453 11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the solder equipment. 12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. 13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to cover the first piece of tape. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE SLEEVES TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit IMPORTANT: Use only dura seal splice sleeves. Other splice sleeves may not protect the splice from moisture or provide a good electrical connection. Use duraseal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. Use duraseal splice sleeves where there is special requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire using duraseal splice sleeves. Page 5744 Open the harness by removing any tape. 2. Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. 3. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 4. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent american wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 5. Slide a section of high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing down the length of wire to be spliced. Ensure that the shrink tubing will not interfere with the splice procedure. 6. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 7. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. 8. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 9. Insert the wire into the DuraSeal splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 10. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Page 8328 Page 4220 1. Apply sealant to the threads of the oil pressure sensor. Refer to Sealers, Adhesives, and Lubricants for the correct part number. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Using J 41712 or equivalent, install the oil pressure sensor. Tighten the sensor to 35 N.m (26 lb ft). 3. Connect the oil pressure sensor electrical connector (1). 4. Install the intake manifold. Refer to Intake Manifold Replacement. Page 5579 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry one side of the nose piece up to the pre-stage position. When the nose piece is in the pre-staged position, the nose piece will be raised above the connector body the length of the step in the nose piece. 7. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry the other side of the piece to the pre-stage position. If the nose piece is higher than the first step in the nose piece, gently push down on the nose piece until it meets with resistance from the connector body, you should feel the nose piece click into position. Page 6202 difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Bosch Connectors (ECM) BOSCH CONNECTORS (ECM) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the assist lever on the top of the connector. Move the assist lever to the forward position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 7563 US English/Metric Conversion US English/Metric Conversion Page 4694 7. Wrap electrical tape around the connection as shown. 8. Route the engine coolant heater cord and extension cord behind the alternator and adjacent to the engine coolant crossover pipe as shown. 9. Continue to route the extension cord to the exit location desired by the customer as shown. 10. Review the routing of the coolant heater cord and extension cord to verify that it does not touch any sharp edges that could damage it. 11. Secure the engine coolant heater cord and the extension cord with tie straps as needed. 12. Resecure any of the original clips that retained the engine coolant heater cord to the vehicle that were released to provide length. Part Information The extension cord may be obtained at any of the following outlets: - Lowes* - Home Depot* - Canada: Acklands-Grainger* (www.acklandsgrainger.com), Catalogue Part Number: CWRSJTOW3C14-10 USA: Cords should bear the UL symbol. Canada: Cords should bear the ULc symbol or CSA approval. *We believe these sources and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume any responsibility for the products or material from these firms or for any such items that may be available from other sources. Locations Yaw Rate Sensor: Locations Antilock Brake System Component Views Under Front Passenger Seat 1 - Yaw Rate and Lateral Acceleration Sensor Page 3029 6. Heater outlet hose to engine (6). 7. Heater inlet hose to front of dash (7). 8. Heater outlet hose to front of dash (8). Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models) Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models) Page 4842 4. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the rear of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. 5. Once the locking tabs are unlocked, slide the inner connector out of the rear of the connector housing. Page 3764 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully raise the TPA on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA cannot be removed from the connector while there are terminals present in the connector body. View of the TPA when removed from the connector body. 4. Use the J 38125-12A tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the left side of the terminal release cavity as shown in the graphic. Use the tool to move the terminal release to the right with a gentle prying motion. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 1923 If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the DuraSeal splice sleeves. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: - Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. - Do not use the crimp and DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 to crimp DuraSeal splice sleeve. In order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 5964 - Most Molex connectors will have the Molex logo on the dresscover of the connector. In some cases the connectors may have MX followed by another letter. The third letter indicates where the connector was made. A connector with MXD is a Molex connector made in Detroit. Sumitomo has a unique symbol on their connector and possibly a part number. The symbol is similar to that of a diamond lying on its side, similar to that shown. The logo could appear anywhere but the most common place is at the wire side of the housing. Tyco/AMP has many different and unique connector designs. Some may or may not have identifiable marks on them. Page 6199 View of connector in released position. 4. Disconnect the connector from the component. 5. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Release the rear lower half of the wiredress cover. Page 5203 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the rear TPA from the connector. 7. IMPORTANT: The front TPA cannot be removed from the connector. Only move it to the release point. Use a small flat-blade tool to move the front TPA to the release position. 8. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 9. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Molex Connectors Page 8026 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the TPA. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the nose piece. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. Page 5523 Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Page 6309 Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested: - Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. - Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a component or to other harnesses. - If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A TEST LAMP TOOLS REQUIRED J 35616-200 Test Light - Probe Kit NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminate even though voltage is present. The J 35616-200 is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair of leads. To properly operate this tool use the following procedures. When testing for voltage: 1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested. When testing for ground: 1. Attach one lead to battery positive voltage. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where ground should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is ground at the point being tested. Using Connector Test Adapters USING CONNECTOR TEST ADAPTERS NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Using Fused Jumper Wires USING FUSED JUMPER WIRES TOOLS REQUIRED J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged. The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested. AFL/ECP Connectors AFL/EPC CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 1977 View of connector in released position. 4. Disconnect the connector from the component. 5. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Release the rear lower half of the wiredress cover. Page 793 Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Testing and Inspection Powertrain Relay Diagnosis Diagnostic Instructions * Perform the Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle prior to using this diagnostic procedure. * Strategy Based Diagnosis for an overview of the diagnostic approach. * Diagnostic Procedure Instructions provide an overview of each diagnostic category. Typical Scan Tool Data Circuit/System Description The powertrain relay is a normally open relay. The relay armature is held in the open position by spring tension. Battery positive voltage is supplied directly to the relay coil and the armature contact at all times. The engine control module (ECM) supplies the ground path to the relay coil control circuit via an internal integrated circuit called an output driver module (ODM). The ODM output control is configured to operate as a low side driver for the powertrain relay. The ODM for the powertrain relay also incorporates a fault detection circuit, which is continuously monitored by the ECM. When the ECM commands the powertrain relay ON, ignition 1 voltage is supplied to the ECM, and to several additional circuits. Diagnostic Aids This test procedure requires that the vehicle battery has passed a load test and is completely charged. Refer to Battery Inspection/Test. See: Starting and Charging/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics/Battery Inspection/Test Circuit/System Verification Important: On the scan tool, the powertrain relay is referred to as the EC ignition relay. 1. Ignition ON, engine OFF, command the powertrain relay ON and OFF several times using the scan tool output control function. You should either hear or feel the relay click with each command. 2. Ignition ON, engine OFF, with a test lamp, probe both test points of all the fuses that are powered by the powertrain relay. The test lamp should illuminate on at least one test point of each fuse. ‹› If the vehicle passes the Circuit/System Verification test, then operate the vehicle within the Conditions for Running the DTC. You may also operate the vehicle within the conditions that are captured in the Freeze Frame/Failure Records Data list. Circuit/System Testing 1. Ignition OFF, disconnect the powertrain relay. 2. Ignition ON, verify that a test lamp does not illuminate between the relay coil control circuit and ground. ‹› If the test lamp illuminates, test the relay coil control circuit for a short to voltage. If the circuit tests normal, replace the ECM. 3. Verify that a test lamp does not illuminate between the relay ignition 1 voltage circuit and ground. ‹› If the test lamp illuminates, test the relay ignition 1 voltage circuit for a short to voltage. If the circuit tests normal, replace the ECM. 4. Verify that a test lamp illuminates between the relay coil B+ and ground. ‹› If the test lamp does not illuminate, test the relay coil B+ circuit for a short to ground or an open/high resistance. 5. Verify that a test lamp illuminates between the relay switch B+ and ground. ‹› If the test lamp does not illuminate, test the relay switch B+ circuit for a short to ground or an open/high resistance. If the circuits test normal and the fuse for the ignition 1 voltage circuit is open, test the ignition 1 voltage circuit to the ECM for a short to ground. If the circuit tests Page 1736 pulling it through. This will prevent damage to the internal seals of the connector. Once the terminal is pushed out of the connector, cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible and pull the wire through the connector. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE The Micro-Pack 100W connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool was developed to crimp Micro-Pack 100W terminals. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 2. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert the terminal into the crimp tool until the core wings are flush with the anvil on the crimp tool. Be sure that the wings are pointed toward the crimp tool former and release the spring locator. The locator will hold the terminal in place. Inspect the alignment of the terminal wings with the crimp tool former. If the terminal wings are wider than the crimp tool former, remove the terminal and bend the terminal wings in slightly. 5. Place stripped wire into terminal. 6. Crimp the new terminal to the wire. If a jam occurs, press the emergency release to open applicator. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire perform the following procedure in order to replace Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. Page 2157 5. While pushing the terminal forward, insert the J 38125-24 in the release cavity above the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (43-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Page 5515 Page 6989 8. Disconnect the 32-way tan electrical connector (2) from the BCM. 9. Disconnect the 24-way gray electrical connector (1) from the BCM. 10. With an upward motion, disconnect the body wiring extension (1) from the rear electrical center. 11. Remove the body wiring extension from the vehicle. INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 1. IMPORTANT: Ensure the sliding latch is fully extended before connecting the body wiring extension to the rear electrical center. Using a downward motion, install the body wiring extension (1) to the rear electrical center. 2. Connect the 24-way gray electrical connector (1) to the BCM. 3. Connect the 32-way tan electrical connector (2) to the BCM. 4. Connect the body wiring extension (1) to the BCM. Page 3796 The engine harness may be repaired using the J-38125. High Temperature Wiring Repairs HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperatures, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time may use materials i.e. wires, connectors, and shielding that has a higher heat rating than typical wiring. When making a repair in a high temperature area observe the following: Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature to replace any damaged wire. - Replace any heat shielding that is removed. - Cover any DuraSeal splice sleeves with SCT1 shrink tubing (available in the J-38125 Terminal Repair kit). - After making a wiring repair, ensure that the location of the wiring is not moved closer to the heat source. IDENTIFYING HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperature, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time need special considerations when making wiring repairs. Areas that may be exposed to higher temperatures can be identified by heat resistant materials that are being used in those areas. These materials may include heat reflective tape, moon tape, and high temperature shrink tubing. Also conduit and other protective coverings may be used. Because conduit or similar coverings are used throughout the vehicle regardless of the temperature, it may be necessary for the technician to determine if an area is exposed to excessive heat before making a wiring repair. Obvious areas of consideration would be any area located near the exhaust manifolds, catalytic converter, and exhaust pipes. The J-38125 contains much of the material you will need to perform repairs on areas exposed to high heat. The kit contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves to crimp and seal connections - High temperature SCT1 shrink tubing to protect the splice sleeves - A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct crimp tool to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools to remove the terminals from the connectors The J-38125 does not contain wire that is suitable to high temperature exposure. Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature of the same or larger gage size as the original wire when repair damage wire. Also replace any reflective tape that you remove during the repair. HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature rating of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125 and then encapsulate the splice sleeve using the high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the order listed. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip keeping all of the wire strands intact. Page 7417 5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape. Seat Belt Schematic Icons Seat Belt Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons Page 7644 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) and slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. Page 7381 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. 4. Remove the dress cover by using a flat bladed tool to release the dress cover locking tabs and lift up on the dress cover. 5. Cut the tie wrap that holds the wires to the connector body. Page 4078 Installation Procedure 1. Wipe the excess oil from the oil filter mounting. 2. Lubricate the oil filter seal with clean engine oil. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 3. Install the oil filter to the oil pan. Tighten the filter to 30 N.m (22 lb ft). 4. Wipe the excess oil from the drain plug hole. 5. Install the oil drain plug to the oil pan. Tighten the oil pan drain plug to 25 N.m (18 lb ft). Page 3455 Fuse Block - Rear C4 (Pin A1 To A16) Page 384 View of a typical Micro 64 connector. Depress the lock and pull the lever over and past the lock. Page 782 Engine Control Module (ECM) C3 (Pin 60 To 73) Page 3382 4. Once the front 2 locks are unlocked, lift the front of the dress cover and pull it forward. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the small slot on the TPA and pushing down until the TPA releases. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to angle or rock the J 38125-21 tool when inserting it into the connector or the tool may break. Insert the J 38125-21 (GM P/N 15381651-2) tool into the round canal between the terminals cavities at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to repair Micro 64 connector terminals. The Micro 64 connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-64 (M jaw) was developed to crimp Micro 64 terminals. The J 38125-64 crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. The J 38125-64 crimping tool is also designed to crimp both the wire and the insulation at the same time. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro 64 terminals. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. 1. Cut the wire as close to the damaged terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. Page 5887 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches, and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original. - The wires insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the possibility of fuel contact. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1). 5. Select the proper duraseal splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool. Refer to the Crimp and Seal Splice Table. 6. Place the duraseal splice sleeve in the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115) crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 7. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to hold the duraseal splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 8. Insert the wires into the duraseal splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel in order to prevent the wire from passing through the splice (3). 9. Close the handles of the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115), until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is applied to the splice sleeve. 10. Shrink the insulation around the splice. - Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. - Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Splicing Inline Harness Diodes SPLICING INLINE HARNESS DIODES Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure. 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode. 2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool. 5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode. Page 7035 - In some cases Delphi will actually be printed on the connector. If Delphi is not printed on the connector, look for PED. In both cases there is no specific orientation for Delphi or PED and they can appear anywhere on the connector. - FCI connectors may have the FCI logo on their connectors. The logo is the letters FCI with an "A" above it. - JAE connector have JAE in small letters on their connectors. Page 489 - Kostel - Molex - Sumitomo - Tyco/AMP - Yazaki Identifying the manufacturer of a connector is often difficult. When trying to determine the manufacturer of a connector, look for specific identifying marks that are unique to that connector supplier. Most of these identify marks are hard to find or see. Check the connector carefully and refer to the information below for pictures and descriptions of connector identification markings. - Most of AFLs connectors have EPC on their connector body. Some of the smaller connectors will not have any markings on them. - In some cases Bosch will actually be printed on the connector. If Bosch does not appear on the connector, look for the Bosch logo. The Bosch logo is a circle with a blunted arrow inside. This logo can appear anywhere on the connector and is often very small. Page 248 View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. View of the release tool being used for the smaller terminals. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (2-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 4846 5. While pushing the terminal forward, insert the J 38125-24 in the release cavity above the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (43-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Electrical - Proper Jump Starting Procedure Jump Starting: Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - Proper Jump Starting Procedure Bulletin No.: 04-06-03-005A Date: May 17, 2006 INFORMATION Subject: Proper Connection Information to Avoid Blown 125 Amp Fuse and Various Interior Electrical System Conditions When Jump Starting Vehicle Models: 2004-2007 Buick Rainier 2002-2007 Chevrolet TrailBlazer, TrailBlazer EXT 2002-2007 GMC Envoy, Envoy XL 2004-2005 GMC Envoy XUV 2002-2004 Oldsmobile Bravada 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 04-06-03-005 (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). It has been found that some dealers may be using the IP battery positive stud at the underhood fuse block to jump start the vehicle. This bulletin is being issued to inform dealers that investigation has indicated the 125 amp mega fuse (no. 48) located in the engine compartment fuse block may be blown resulting in various electrical system conditions due to using this improper connection. To properly jump start the vehicle, you must always use the following connections. For the positive connection, use the battery terminal. For the negative connection, use the remote terminal located on the front engine lift bracket (marked "GND"). Page 7987 IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals. Front probe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the connector. IMPORTANT: When probing female 0.64 terminals, it is important to use the correct adapter. There have been some revisions to the test adapter for 0.64 terminals. The proper adapter for 0.64 terminals is the J 35616-64B which has a gold terminal and a black wire between the base and tip. Failure to use the proper test adapter may result in damage to the terminal being tested and improper diagnosis. NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Page 1916 Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size. REPAIRING A FUSIBLE LINK IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient overload protection. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. Flat Wire Repairs FLAT WIRE REPAIRS NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced. GMLAN Wiring Repairs GMLAN WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The GM Local Area Network (GMLAN) System requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working on GMLAN connectors and terminals. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items in order to repair the GMLAN wiring: Dura Seal splice sleeves - A wire stripping tool - J 38125-8 Crimping Tool (GM P/N 12085115) - J 38125-5 Ultra Torch Special Tool (GM P/N 12085116) The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. - A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors GMLAN REPAIRS IMPORTANT: When making a repair to any GMLAN network, the original wire length after the repair must be the same length as before the repair. If the network is a twisted pair, the twist must be maintained after the repair is completed. GMLAN has 2 types of networks, low speed and high speed. Low speed GMLAN has a single wire and works at slow speeds. High speed GMLAN has 2 wires in a twisted pair and works at higher speeds. For more information on GMLAN, refer to Data Link Communications Description and Operation. GMLAN CONNECTOR TERMINAL REPAIR IMPORTANT: A service terminal can be used to replace damaged connector terminals for both high speed and low speed GMLAN systems. When making a connector terminal repair on a GMLAN high speed system with twisted pair wires, do not untwist the wires more than necessary to make the repair. The terminals in the GMLAN system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are available in the J-38125. If the individual terminals are damaged on any GMLAN connection, use the appropriate connector repair procedure in order to repair the terminal. GMLAN WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 521 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry one side of the nose piece up to the pre-stage position. When the nose piece is in the pre-staged position, the nose piece will be raised above the connector body the length of the step in the nose piece. 7. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry the other side of the piece to the pre-stage position. If the nose piece is higher than the first step in the nose piece, gently push down on the nose piece until it meets with resistance from the connector body, you should feel the nose piece click into position. Page 4117 under pressure if the radiator cap or the surge tank cap is removed while the engine and radiator are still hot. 4. Remove the surge tank fill cap from the surge tank or the coolant pressure cap from the radiator. 5. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle in SI. 6. Place a clean drain pan under the radiator drain cock or under the lower radiator hose depending on the vehicle. Refer to Cooling System Draining and Filling in SI. 7. Loosen the radiator drain cock if equipped or use J 38185 clamp pliers and reposition the clamp on the lower radiator hose at the radiator. 8. Remove the end of the lower radiator hose from the radiator. 9. Drain the engine coolant sufficiently below the level of the ECT sensor. 10. Close the radiator drain cock or connect the lower radiator hose at the radiator. 11. Use the J 38185 clamp pliers to place the clamp into the original position on the hose. 12. Lower the vehicle. 13. Disconnect the wiring harness connector from the ECT sensor (2). 14. Remove the ECT sensor (1) from the front of the cylinder head. 15. Remove the corresponding size plug at the rear of the OTHER cylinder head. 16. Coat the threads of the ECT sensor with sealer. Use GM P/N 12346004 (Canadian P/N 10953480) or an equivalent. 17. Install the ECT sensor in the hole of the cylinder head where the plug was removed. Tighten Tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb ft). 18. Coat the threads of the plug with sealer. Use GM P/N 12346004 (Canadian P/N 10953480) or an equivalent. 19. Install the plug in the hole of the cylinder head where the ECT sensor was removed Tighten Tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb ft). Important Leave enough wire attached to the ECT sensor harness connector in order to create manageable splices that are at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splice. Locations Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay: Locations Fuse Block - Underhood (5.3L/6.0L), Label Page 412 8. Insert the J 38125-213 into the small terminal release hole on the nose piece and gently pull on the back of the wire. 9. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Repairing Connector Terminals REPAIRING CONNECTOR TERMINALS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following: Push to Seat terminals - Pull to Seat terminals Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your terminal repair. The J-38125 contains further information. 1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.For cable seal terminals, remove the seal. 2. Apply the correct cable seal per gage size of the wire, if used.Slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation removal. 3. Remove the insulation. 4. For sealed terminals only, align the seal with the end of the cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal.For sealed terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal. 6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.For sealed terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable. 8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals excepting Micro-Pack 100.64 size. Soldering Micro-Pack 100 World terminals may damage the terminal. Sumitomo Connectors SUMITOMO CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 8937 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. JST Connectors JST CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, remove the connector from the component. Page 4189 3. Install J 41479 tapered cone (2) and bolts onto the rear of the crankshaft. 4. Tighten the bolts until snug. Do not overtighten. 5. Install the rear oil seal onto the tapered cone (2) and push the seal to the rear cover bore. 6. Thread J 41479 threaded rod into the tapered cone until the tool (1) contacts the oil seal. 7. Align the oil seal into the tool (1). 8. Rotate the handle of the tool (1) clockwise until the seal enters the rear cover and bottoms into the cover bore. 9. Remove J 41479. 10. Install the engine flywheel. Refer to Engine Flywheel Replacement. Page 7835 If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the DuraSeal splice sleeves. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: - Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. - Do not use the crimp and DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 to crimp DuraSeal splice sleeve. In order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 2429 Refer to the following table as a guide in selecting the correct test adapter for front probing connectors: Backprobe IMPORTANT: Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures. - Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector. - Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large of a test probe. - After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected, test for proper terminal contact. Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the connector. Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure SCAN TOOL SNAPSHOT PROCEDURE Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used Page 6129 4. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the rear of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. 5. Once the locking tabs are unlocked, slide the inner connector out of the rear of the connector housing. Page 2118 Depress the locks that are located on both sides of the wiredress cover and pull the lever over and past the locks. View of the connector when released from the component. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the front of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool push down on one of the locking tabs and pull the cover up until the dress cover releases. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. Page 8577 6. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by pressing on the tang. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (SENSOR) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) tool into the cavity on the lower right hand face of the connector until the terminal release tang access panel slides over. Locations Steering Wheel And Column Engine - Low Oil Lamp ON/Oil Leaks Oil Pressure Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Low Oil Lamp ON/Oil Leaks TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 07-06-01-004A Date: November 25, 2008 Subject: All Vortec(R) GEN IV V8 Engines - LY2 LS4 LC9 LH6 LMG LY5 LS2 L76 LY6 L92 LS7, Low Oil Level Indicator Lamp On and/or Engine Oil Leak (Reseal Oil Pressure Sensor) Models Supercede: This bulletin is being updated to include a labor operation number for CTS-V and Corvette models. Please discard Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 07-06-01-004 (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System). Condition Some customers may comment on a low oil level indicator lamp on and/or engine oil leak. Upon further investigation, the technician may find that the oil leak is at the oil pressure sensor that is threaded into the valve lifter oil manifold (VLOM) assembly and/or engine valley cover. Correction If the engine oil leak was found to be at the engine oil pressure sensor, then remove the oil pressure sensor and reseal with a pipe sealant with Teflon or equivalent, P/N 12346004 (in Canada, P/N 10953480). Refer to Engine Oil Pressure Sensor and/or Switch Replacement in SI. Parts Information Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models) Page 2384 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert a small flat-blade tool in the slot below the front loaded terminal position assurance (TPA) and pry up. 3. Remove the TPA by pulling it out of the connector. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-553 (GM P/N 15315247) on a slight upward angle into the cavity below the terminal to be removed. Ensure that the pointed on the end of the tool is facing the bottom of the terminal and it stays in contact with the terminal until it stops on the plastic terminal retainer. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 8837 9. The illustration shows a cutaway view of the connector to aid the technician in releasing the terminal retainer. 10. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Terminal Position Assurance Locks TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Tyco/Amp Connectors (CM 42-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (CM 42-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the connector body and pull the CPA out. The CPA is on the wire harness side of connector. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 4456 5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape. Seat Belt Schematic Icons Seat Belt Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons Page 6473 3. Use a small flat-bladed tool to gently pry off the dress cover by inserting the tool under the cover opposite the harness side and prying up. 4. Remove the cover. 5. Using a small flat-bladed tool, push on the side of the nose piece retainer while pushing the nose piece forward with your thumb. This will release the terminal position assurance (TPA). 6. Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) into the corresponding terminal release cavity. The release cavities are the 2 center rows of cavities on one half of the connector. Page 1293 Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Service and Repair Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure Notice: Handle the electronic throttle control components carefully. Use cleanliness in order to prevent damage. Do not drop the electronic throttle control components. Do not roughly handle the electronic throttle control components. Do not immerse the electronic throttle control components in cleaning solvents of any type. 1. Disconnect the accelerator pedal position (APP) sensor electrical connector. 2. Remove the 3 APP sensor bolts (1). 3. Remove the APP sensor (2). Installation Procedure 1. Install the APP sensor. Page 5884 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the DuraSeal splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of a connector. CPAs are used in all SIR System connectors and also in some connectors of other systems. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals of a connection. TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE CLIPS IMPORTANT: When making a splice in an area that may be exposed to moisture use a crimp and seal splice sleeve instead of a Splice Clip. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. Page 6962 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches, and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original. - The wires insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the possibility of fuel contact. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1). 5. Select the proper duraseal splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool. Refer to the Crimp and Seal Splice Table. 6. Place the duraseal splice sleeve in the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115) crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 7. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to hold the duraseal splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 8. Insert the wires into the duraseal splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel in order to prevent the wire from passing through the splice (3). 9. Close the handles of the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115), until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is applied to the splice sleeve. 10. Shrink the insulation around the splice. - Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. - Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Splicing Inline Harness Diodes SPLICING INLINE HARNESS DIODES Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure. 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode. 2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool. 5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode. Page 5630 20. Extract a portion of the ECT sensor harness wiring and connector from the protective conduit. Cut off the ECT sensor harness connector and wiring. 21. Determine a routing path for the ECT sensor jumper harness wires so that they can be secured TO or WITHIN an existing protective conduit. Note This step is to set up and verify the length of wiring that is required before cutting. 22. Route the ECT sensor jumper wires and then enclose them in their own protective conduit in order to VERIFY the length that is required. 23. Cut the ECT sensor jumper wires to the appropriate length. Note Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splice or connector. 24. Splice the ECT sensor jumper wires to the ORIGINAL ECT HARNESS LOCATION using DuraSeal weatherproof splices. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves in SI. Note Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splice or connector. 25. Splice the ECT sensor jumper wires to the ECT SENSOR HARNESS CONNECTOR using DuraSeal weatherproof splices. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves in SI. 26. Connect the ECT sensor harness connector to the ECT sensor. 27. Secure the ECT sensor jumper wires that are in their own protective conduit TO or WITHIN the existing harness conduit using tie straps. Important You MUST run the engine at the specified RPM and until it reaches normal operating temperature and then allow it to idle as indicated in SI. The engine MUST then be allowed to cool down in order to top off the coolant level as needed. 28. Fill the cooling system to the proper level. Refer to Cooling System Draining and Filling in SI. 29. Pressure test the cooling system. Refer to Cooling System Leak Testing in SI. 30. Use a scan tool to clear any DTCs. Relocating the Engine Coolant Heater Cord Important For reference, the procedure and graphics that are shown are from a Chevrolet Silverado, but are similar for the other vehicles listed above. 1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Ask the customer where they would prefer the extension cord to exit from the engine compartment in order to determine the required extension cord length. 3. Obtain an extension cord with the following features: - 120 volt - 14/3 gauge - 15A capacity - Three prong - Polarized plug and receptacle - Chemical resistant - Grounded terminals - Designed for use in a cold outdoor environment - Outer jacket resistant to deterioration from moisture, abrasion and exposure to sunlight - Maximum length of 2.5-3 m (8-10 ft) 4. Release enough of the clips that retain the engine coolant heater cord to the vehicle to provide the necessary length for repositioning. 5. Apply dielectric grease to the electrical contacts of the heater cord receptacle and the extension cord plug to prevent corrosion. Use GM P/N 12345579 (in Canada, use P/N 10953481) or an equivalent. 6. Connect the heater cord receptacle to the extension cord plug and wipe OFF any excess grease. Page 3874 7. Rotate the crankshaft until the number one piston is at top dead center (TDC) of the compression stroke. In this position, cylinder number one rocker arms will be off lobe lift, and the crankshaft sprocket key will be at the 1:30 position. The engine firing order is 1, 8, 7, 2, 6, 5, 4, 3. Cylinders 1, 3, 5 and 7 are the left bank. Cylinder 2, 4, 6 and 8 are the right bank. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 8. With the engine in the number one firing position, tighten the following valve rocker arm bolts: ^ Tighten cylinders 1, 2, 7 and 8 exhaust valve rocker arm bolts to 30 N.m (22 lb ft). ^ Tighten cylinders 1, 3, 4 and 5 intake valve rocker arm bolts to 30 N.m (22 lb ft). ^ Rotate the crankshaft 360 degrees. ^ Tighten the following valve rocker arm bolts: ^ Tighten cylinders 3, 4, 5 and 6 exhaust valve rocker arm bolts to 30 N.m (22 lb ft). ^ Tighten cylinders 2, 6, 7 and 8 intake valve rocker arm bolts to 30 N.m (22 lb ft). ^ Install the valve rocker arm cover. Refer to Valve Rocker Arm Cover Replacement - Left Side or to Valve Rocker Arm Cover Replacement - Right Side. Page 4824 2. Locate the two indents of the terminal position assurance (TPA) located on the bottom of the connector body. Page 8919 View of a typical Micro 64 connector. Depress the lock and pull the lever over and past the lock. Page 7365 TERMINAL REMOVAL Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors. 1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA) device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1). 3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 4. Gently pull the cable and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector. 5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal, refer to Terminal Repair. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3. Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector. REINSTALLING TERMINAL 1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly, refer to Wiring Repairs. 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3. Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) DELPHI CONNECTORS (WEATHER PACK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 8692 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the TPA. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the nose piece. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. Page 5530 If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200 DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J 39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected. IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J 39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and maximum (MAX) values measured. 1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of a suspected circuit to the other. 2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J 39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep). IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value in order to record the full change. 5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling the connections or the wiring, test driving, or performing other operations. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions. 6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9. Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist. Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections TESTING FOR INTERMITTENT CONDITIONS AND POOR CONNECTIONS TOOLS REQUIRED - J 35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit - J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit When the condition is not currently present, but is indicated in DTC history, the cause may be intermittent. An intermittent may also be the cause when there is a customer complaint, but the symptom cannot be duplicated. Refer to the Symptom Table of the system that is suspect of causing the condition before trying to locate an intermittent condition. Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the following items: Wiring broken inside the insulation - Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector - Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself, and corrosion in the wire to terminal contact area, etc. - Pierced or damaged insulation can allow moisture to enter the wiring causing corrosion. The conductor can corrode inside the insulation, with little visible evidence. Look for swollen and stiff sections of wire in the suspect circuits. - Wiring which has been pinched, cut, or its insulation rubbed through may cause an intermittent open or short as the bare area touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle. - Wiring that comes in contact with hot or exhaust components - Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required, in order to verify the customer concern. - Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. - Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis and Vehicle Data Recorder operation. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any inline connectors before replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation. Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination, usually in the underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit. Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper adapter. Always use the J 35616 when probing connectors. Other causes of terminal deformation are improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT IN BUSSED ELECTRICAL CENTERS (BEC) Page 495 View of the connector when released from the component. View of another type of Micro 64 connector. Page 756 breakers are used. CIRCUIT BREAKER This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high current is removed. POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) CIRCUIT BREAKER This type greatly increases its resistance when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker will re-close within a second or 2. Circuit Protection - Fuses CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSES The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and examine the element in the fuse for an open (2). If not broken (1), also check for continuity using a DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one of equal current rating. Circuit Protection - Fusible Links CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSIBLE LINKS Page 8946 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry one side of the nose piece up to the pre-stage position. When the nose piece is in the pre-staged position, the nose piece will be raised above the connector body the length of the step in the nose piece. 7. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry the other side of the piece to the pre-stage position. If the nose piece is higher than the first step in the nose piece, gently push down on the nose piece until it meets with resistance from the connector body, you should feel the nose piece click into position. Page 8399 - In some cases Delphi will actually be printed on the connector. If Delphi is not printed on the connector, look for PED. In both cases there is no specific orientation for Delphi or PED and they can appear anywhere on the connector. - FCI connectors may have the FCI logo on their connectors. The logo is the letters FCI with an "A" above it. - JAE connector have JAE in small letters on their connectors. Page 6277 5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape. Seat Belt Schematic Icons Seat Belt Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons Page 7520 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully raise the TPA on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA cannot be removed from the connector while there are terminals present in the connector body. View of the TPA when removed from the connector body. 4. Use the J 38125-12A tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the left side of the terminal release cavity as shown in the graphic. Use the tool to move the terminal release to the right with a gentle prying motion. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 2444 6. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs located on the opposite side of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover at the connector end and pry up. 7. Remove the dress cover. 8. Cut the tie wrap on the wire bundle. 9. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting a small flat-bladed tool into the small slot in the end of the slider and pushing on the TPA until it comes out of the connector. When the TPA exits the opposite side of the connector, gasp the TPA and pull it completely out of the connector. 10. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 6412 vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide variety of actions, including: - Wiggling the harness - Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting - Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector - Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation - Relocating a harness or wires All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. Another option is, with the component commanded ON and OFF by the scan tool, move related connectors and wiring and observe the component operation. With the engine running, move related connectors and wiring while monitoring engine operation. If harness or connector movement affects the data displayed, component/system operation, or engine operation, inspect and repair the harness/connections as necessary. You may need to load the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these cases you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide good results as well. There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions, along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the circuit to these kinds of conditions. SALT WATER SPRAY Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture. Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5 percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously. HIGH TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070. Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault condition. The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis. This option does not allow for the same control, however. LOW TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect. If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to -18°C (0°F) from one end and +71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized cooling needs. Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or components in an effort to duplicate the concern. DUPLICATING FAILURE CONDITIONS - If none of the previous tests are successful, attempt to duplicate and/or capture the failure conditions. Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, where applicable, contains the conditions that were present when the DTC set. 1. Review and record Freeze Frame/Failure Records data. 2. Clear the DTCs using the scan tool. 3. Turn the key to OFF and wait 15 seconds. 4. Operate the vehicle under the same conditions that were noted in Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, as closely as possible. The vehicle must also be operating within the Conditions for Running the DTC. Refer to Conditions for Running the DTC in the supporting text if a DTC is being diagnosed. 5. Monitor DTC Status for the DTC being tested. The scan tool will indicate Ran, when the enabling conditions have been satisfied long enough for the DTC to run. The scan tool will also indicate whether the DTC passed or failed. - An alternate method is to drive the vehicle with the DMM connected to a suspected circuit. An abnormal reading on the DMM when the concern occurs, may help you locate the concern. Measuring Frequency Page 4153 For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 5006 Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Locations Engine Controls Component Views Left Side of Engine - Front 1 - Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor 2 - G108 Page 7814 7. Pressing the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool in the release cavity of the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and crimper in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (DOOR MODULE) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Side view of connector. View of top of connector. 1. Locate the assist lever and lock on the top of the connector. Page 3815 Repair Instructions Perform the Diagnostic Repair Verification after completing the diagnostic procedure. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests and Procedures Page 7986 MEASURING FREQUENCY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal. IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM to autorange to an appropriate range. 1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency measured. Measuring Voltage MEASURING VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit. 1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods: - Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. - Turn ON the engine. - Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls. - Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested. 3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The DMM displays the voltage measured at that point. Measuring Voltage Drop MEASURING VOLTAGE DROP NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points. Probing Electrical Connectors PROBING ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS Page 7525 MOLEX CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. 2. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. Page 1207 Parts required to complete this service update are to be obtained from Saab Parts Distribution Center (PDC). Service Procedure Tools Required J 45722 or equivalent 1. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle in SI. (1) Fuel Tank Label (2) fuel Tank (3) Rear Axle 2. Locate the fuel tank label (1), which is on the backside of the fuel tank (2) below the fuel tank filler neck. 3. Inspect the fuel tank for a white "X" on the fuel tank and/or a green "C" on the barcode. ^ If a white "X" on the fuel tank and/or a green "C" on the barcode is found, the fuel sender assembly does not require replacement. No further action is required. ^ If a white "X" on the fuel tank and/or a green "C" on the barcode is not found, proceed to Step 4 for additional inspection. Page 2400 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches, and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original. - The wires insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the possibility of fuel contact. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1). 5. Select the proper duraseal splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool. Refer to the Crimp and Seal Splice Table. 6. Place the duraseal splice sleeve in the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115) crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 7. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to hold the duraseal splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 8. Insert the wires into the duraseal splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel in order to prevent the wire from passing through the splice (3). 9. Close the handles of the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115), until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is applied to the splice sleeve. 10. Shrink the insulation around the splice. - Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. - Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Splicing Inline Harness Diodes SPLICING INLINE HARNESS DIODES Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure. 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode. 2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool. 5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode. Page 8931 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) and slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. Wheels - Changing Procedures/Precautions Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels - Changing Procedures/Precautions INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 06-03-10-010A Date: June 09, 2010 Subject: Information on Proper Wheel Changing Procedures and Cautions Models: 2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks 2010 and Prior HUMMER Models 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X 2005-2009 Saturn Vehicles Attention: Complete wheel changing instructions for each vehicle line can be found under Tire and Wheel Removal and Installation in Service Information (SI). This bulletin is intended to quickly review and reinforce simple but vital procedures to reduce the possibility of achieving low torque during wheel installation. Always refer to SI for wheel lug nut torque specifications and complete jacking instructions for safe wheel changing. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to include the 2011 model year and update the available special tool list. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 06-03-10-010 (Section 03 Suspension). Frequency of Wheel Changes - Marketplace Driven Just a few years ago, the increasing longevity of tires along with greater resistance to punctures had greatly reduced the number of times wheels were removed to basically required tire rotation intervals. Today with the booming business in accessory wheels/special application tires (such as winter tires), consumers are having tire/wheel assemblies removed - replaced - or installed more than ever. With this increased activity, it opens up more of a chance for error on the part of the technician. This bulletin will review a few of the common concerns and mistakes to make yourself aware of. Proper Servicing Starts With the Right Tools The following tools have been made available to assist in proper wheel and tire removal and installation. - J 41013 Rotor Resurfacing Kit (or equivalent) - J 42450-A Wheel Hub Resurfacing Kit (or equivalent) Corroded Surfaces One area of concern is corrosion on the mating surfaces of the wheel to the hub on the vehicle. Excessive corrosion, dirt, rust or debris built up on these surfaces can mimic a properly tightened wheel in the service stall. Once the vehicle is driven, the debris may loosen, grind up or be washed away from water splash. This action may result in clearance at the mating surface of the wheel and an under-torqued condition. Caution Before installing a wheel, remove any buildup on the wheel mounting surface and brake drum or brake disc mounting surface. Installing wheels with poor metal-to-metal contact at the mounting surfaces can cause wheel nuts to loosen. This may cause a wheel to come off when the vehicle is moving, possibly resulting in a loss of control or personal injury. Whenever you remove the tire/wheel assemblies, you must inspect the mating surfaces. If corrosion is found, you should remove the debris with a die grinder equipped with a fine sanding pad, wire brush or cleaning disc. Just remove enough material to assure a clean, smooth mating surface. The J 41013 (or equivalent) can be used to clean the following surfaces: - The hub mounting surface - The brake rotor mounting surface - The wheel mounting surface Use the J 42450-A (or equivalent) to clean around the base of the studs and the hub. Lubricants, Grease and Fluids Page 1919 The engine harness may be repaired using the J-38125. High Temperature Wiring Repairs HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperatures, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time may use materials i.e. wires, connectors, and shielding that has a higher heat rating than typical wiring. When making a repair in a high temperature area observe the following: Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature to replace any damaged wire. - Replace any heat shielding that is removed. - Cover any DuraSeal splice sleeves with SCT1 shrink tubing (available in the J-38125 Terminal Repair kit). - After making a wiring repair, ensure that the location of the wiring is not moved closer to the heat source. IDENTIFYING HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperature, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time need special considerations when making wiring repairs. Areas that may be exposed to higher temperatures can be identified by heat resistant materials that are being used in those areas. These materials may include heat reflective tape, moon tape, and high temperature shrink tubing. Also conduit and other protective coverings may be used. Because conduit or similar coverings are used throughout the vehicle regardless of the temperature, it may be necessary for the technician to determine if an area is exposed to excessive heat before making a wiring repair. Obvious areas of consideration would be any area located near the exhaust manifolds, catalytic converter, and exhaust pipes. The J-38125 contains much of the material you will need to perform repairs on areas exposed to high heat. The kit contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves to crimp and seal connections - High temperature SCT1 shrink tubing to protect the splice sleeves - A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct crimp tool to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools to remove the terminals from the connectors The J-38125 does not contain wire that is suitable to high temperature exposure. Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature of the same or larger gage size as the original wire when repair damage wire. Also replace any reflective tape that you remove during the repair. HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature rating of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125 and then encapsulate the splice sleeve using the high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the order listed. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip keeping all of the wire strands intact. Page 9043 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Ensure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the Terminal Removal Procedure. Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PULL TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL If the terminal is visibly damaged or is suspected of having a faulty connection, the terminal should be replaced. Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors: 1. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) device and/or the secondary lock. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component or separate the connectors for in-line connectors. 3. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device. 4. Insert the proper pick or removal tool into the front of the connector body. 5. IMPORTANT: On connectors with more than one terminal the service loop may not be large enough to remove the terminal and crimp on a new one. If the terminal wire does not have a large enough service loop for removal, cut the wire 5 cm (2 in) behind the connector before removal. Grasp the wire at the back of the connector body and gently push the terminal out the front of the connector body. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. If the wire needed to be cut in order to remove the terminal, gently push a small length of the same size wire through the back of the connector cavity until there is enough wire exposed in order to crimp on a new terminal. If the wire was not cut, cut the existing wire as close to the old terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 4. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. TERMINAL INSTALLATION 1. Align the terminal and pull the wire from the back of the connector in order to seat the terminal. 2. If necessary, cut the new wire to proper length and splice with existing circuit. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. 3. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply dielectric grease to the connector. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PUSH TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 4335 Processes shown in the Table 3 are capable of recycling waste engine coolants (DEX-COOL(R) or conventional) to a conventional (green) coolant. Recycling conventional coolant can be accomplished at your facility by a technician using approved EQUIPMENT (listed by model number in Table 3), or by an approved coolant recycling SERVICE which may recycle the coolant at your facility or at an offsite operation. Refer to the table for GM approved coolant recyclers in either of these two categories. Should you decide to recycle the coolant yourself, strict adherence to the operating procedures is imperative. Use ONLY the inhibitor chemicals supplied by the respective (GM approved) recycling equipment manufacturer. Sealing Tablets Cooling System Sealing Tablets (Seal Tabs) should not be used as a regular maintenance item after servicing an engine cooling system. Discoloration of coolant can occur if too many seal tabs have been inserted into the cooling system. This can occur if seal tabs are repeatedly used over the service life of a vehicle. Where appropriate, seal tabs may be used if diagnostics fail to repair a small leak in the cooling system. When a condition appears in which seal tabs may be recommended, a specific bulletin will be released describing their proper usage. Water Quality The integrity of the coolant is dependent upon the quality of DEX-COOL(R) and water. DEX-COOL(R) is a product that has enhanced protection capability as well as an extended service interval. These enhanced properties may be jeopardized by combining DEX-COOL(R) with poor quality water. If you suspect the water in your area of being poor quality, it is recommended you use distilled or de-ionized water with DEX-COOL(R). "Pink" DEX-COOL(R) DEX-COOL(R) is orange in color to distinguish it from other coolants. Due to inconsistencies in the mixing of the dyes used with DEX-COOL(R), some batches may appear pink after time. The color shift from orange to pink does not affect the integrity of the coolant, and still maintains the 5 yr/150,000 mile (240,000 km) service interval. Back Service Only use DEX-COOL(R) if the vehicle was originally equipped with DEX-COOL(R). Page 4141 15. Install the transmission oil cooler lines (1) to the retainer (2). 16. Install the oil level indicator tube. Refer to Oil Level Indicator and Tube Replacement. 17. Fill the engine with oil. Refer to Engine Oil and Oil Filter Replacement. 18. Install the front differential. Refer to Differential Carrier Assembly Replacement (4.2L In-Line Six Cylinder) Differential Carrier Assembly Replacement (V8). 19. Connect the negative battery cable. Refer to Battery Negative Cable Disconnection and Connection. Page 1134 Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagrams Engine Controls Connector End Views Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor Page 1726 - Most Molex connectors will have the Molex logo on the dresscover of the connector. In some cases the connectors may have MX followed by another letter. The third letter indicates where the connector was made. A connector with MXD is a Molex connector made in Detroit. Sumitomo has a unique symbol on their connector and possibly a part number. The symbol is similar to that of a diamond lying on its side, similar to that shown. The logo could appear anywhere but the most common place is at the wire side of the housing. Tyco/AMP has many different and unique connector designs. Some may or may not have identifiable marks on them. Page 8423 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully raise the TPA on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA cannot be removed from the connector while there are terminals present in the connector body. View of the TPA when removed from the connector body. 4. Use the J 38125-12A tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the left side of the terminal release cavity as shown in the graphic. Use the tool to move the terminal release to the right with a gentle prying motion. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 5174 - Kostel - Molex - Sumitomo - Tyco/AMP - Yazaki Identifying the manufacturer of a connector is often difficult. When trying to determine the manufacturer of a connector, look for specific identifying marks that are unique to that connector supplier. Most of these identify marks are hard to find or see. Check the connector carefully and refer to the information below for pictures and descriptions of connector identification markings. - Most of AFLs connectors have EPC on their connector body. Some of the smaller connectors will not have any markings on them. - In some cases Bosch will actually be printed on the connector. If Bosch does not appear on the connector, look for the Bosch logo. The Bosch logo is a circle with a blunted arrow inside. This logo can appear anywhere on the connector and is often very small. Page 4940 MOLEX CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. 2. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. Page 6305 to analyze the data during the time a vehicle condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a trigger point that you have determined. Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2 snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a first-in, first-out basis. If a third snapshot is taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost. Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types: Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice - Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200 frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not lost if the Scan Tool is powered down. The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis. The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected values by plotting 3 parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful, especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC. Testing for a Short to Voltage TESTING FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4. Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt, there is a short to voltage in the circuit. Testing for Continuity TESTING FOR CONTINUITY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6. Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit. 7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity. With a Test Lamp IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits. 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6. If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity. Testing for Electrical Intermittents TESTING FOR ELECTRICAL INTERMITTENTS Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment. - Testing for Short to Ground - Testing for Continuity - Testing for a Short to Voltage Page 3374 - Kostel - Molex - Sumitomo - Tyco/AMP - Yazaki Identifying the manufacturer of a connector is often difficult. When trying to determine the manufacturer of a connector, look for specific identifying marks that are unique to that connector supplier. Most of these identify marks are hard to find or see. Check the connector carefully and refer to the information below for pictures and descriptions of connector identification markings. - Most of AFLs connectors have EPC on their connector body. Some of the smaller connectors will not have any markings on them. - In some cases Bosch will actually be printed on the connector. If Bosch does not appear on the connector, look for the Bosch logo. The Bosch logo is a circle with a blunted arrow inside. This logo can appear anywhere on the connector and is often very small. Page 6343 Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. FCI Connectors FCI CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 2585 - Yazaki has a wedge or arrow shape, similar to that shown. Delphi Connectors (Micro .64) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro 64 connectors. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. The lever lock may be located on the top or sides of the wire dress cover. Locations Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Locations Engine Controls Component Views Fuel Tank 1 - Fuel Tank Pressue (FTP) Sensor 2 - Fuel Pump and Sender Assembly 3 - Chassis Harness 4 Fuel Tank 5 - Evaporative Emission (EVAP) Canister Vent Solenoid Page 1650 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link). - The wire insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. 5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold them between thumb and forefinger. 7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place. - Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction. - Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip. 8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool closes.Ensure that no strands of wire are cut. 10. Crimp the splice on each end (2). Page 364 - A control module from another vehicle is installed. - Revised software/calibration files have been released for this vehicle. - IMPORTANT: DO NOT re-program the control module with the SAME software/calibration files that are already present in the control module. This is not an effective repair for any type of concern. Verify that the control module contains the correct software/calibration. If incorrect programming is found, reprogram the control module with the most current software/calibration. Refer to Control Module References for replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Testing for Short to Ground TESTING FOR SHORT TO GROUND NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 4. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit. With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is a short to ground in the circuit. Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2. Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). - When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. - If the DMM does not display voltage 4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is shorted. Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A DIGITAL MULTIMETER NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the powertrain control module (PCM), should only be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200 Digital Multimeter (DMM). The J 39200 instruction manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminage even though voltage is present. The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity. IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading. Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the measurement. Page 4804 - Yazaki has a wedge or arrow shape, similar to that shown. Delphi Connectors (Micro .64) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro 64 connectors. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. The lever lock may be located on the top or sides of the wire dress cover. OnStar(R) - Loss of GPS Signal/Hands Free Issues Emergency Contact Module: Customer Interest OnStar(R) - Loss of GPS Signal/Hands Free Issues Bulletin No.: 02-08-46-007C Date: November 19, 2007 INFORMATION Subject: Information on OnStar(R) System - Possible Loss of GPS Signal, Hands-Free Calling Minutes Expire Prematurely and/or Inability to Add Hands-Free Calling Minutes Models: 2001-2008 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Including Saturn) 2003-2008 HUMMER H2 2006-2008 HUMMER H3 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X with OnStar(R) System (RPO UE1) Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2008 model year, warranty information and to provide GPS signal recovery steps (under Dealer Action heading) to do PRIOR to determining if the VIU/VCIM needs replacement. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 02-08-46-007B (Section 08 - Body & Accessories). If the vehicle currently has analog-upgradable OnStar(R) hardware, then the customer should be made aware of the digital upgrade program per the latest version of Service Bulletin # 05-08-46-006. Any analog OnStar system that is not upgraded prior to the end of 2007 will be deactivated due to the upcoming phase-out of the analog cellular network in the U.S. and Canada. If the vehicle has recently been upgraded or has had a service replacement unit installed, this bulletin may not be applicable. Certain 2001-2008 model year vehicles equipped with OnStar(R) may exhibit a condition with the Global Positioning System (GPS) that causes inaccuracies in the GPS clock. The GPS system is internal to the OnStar(R) Vehicle Interface Unit (VIU) or the Vehicle Communication Interface Module (VCIM). This inaccuracy can result in a symptom where the OnStar(R) Call Center is unable to obtain an accurate GPS signal, hands-Free Calling minutes expire prematurely and/or the inability to add Hands-Free calling minutes. Customer Notification OnStar(R) will notify the customer by mail with instructions to contact their dealership service department. Dealer Action Not all vehicles will require VIU/VCIM replacement. The GPS signal in some vehicles may be recoverable. To determine if the signal is recoverable, simply connect the Tech2(R) and using the GPS information data display option, observe the GPS date and time. If the date/time stamps are equal to a date approximately 19 years in the future, the GPS clock has exceeded its capacity and the VIU/VCIM will need to be replaced. If the date/time stamp is in the past or near future, the GPS clock has simply generated an inaccurate value and may be recoverable by performing the following power-up reset. To initiate a power-up reset, battery voltage (batt. +) must be removed from the VIU/VCIM. The preferred methods, in order, of initiating the reset are outlined below. Remove the fuse that supplies Battery positive (Batt. +) voltage to the module (refer to the applicable Service Information schematics for the appropriate fuse). The next preferred method is to remove the connector to the OnStar(R) unit that Batt + is contained. The least preferable method is to remove the negative terminal of the vehicle battery. This will not only initiate the power-up reset, but it may also result in the loss of radio presets and other stored personalization information/settings in other modules as well. After initiating the power-up reset, the GPS data will be set to the defaulted date and time and will require an acquisition of the GPS signal in order to gain the proper date and time. Acquiring the GPS signal requires running the vehicle in an open/unobstructed view of the sky. First, contact OnStar(R) Technical Support by pressing the blue button. Allow the OnStar(R) Technical Advisor to activate the GPS recovery process. This should take approximately 10 minutes. Continue to Page 2205 Refer to the following table as a guide in selecting the correct test adapter for front probing connectors: Backprobe IMPORTANT: Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures. - Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector. - Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large of a test probe. - After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected, test for proper terminal contact. Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the connector. Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure SCAN TOOL SNAPSHOT PROCEDURE Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used Page 5453 Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. FCI Connectors FCI CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 5690 - Yazaki has a wedge or arrow shape, similar to that shown. Delphi Connectors (Micro .64) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro 64 connectors. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. The lever lock may be located on the top or sides of the wire dress cover. Page 7311 3. Connect the MDI to a PC or laptop that has been downloaded with the GDS application from TIS2WEB. Note At least one Diagnostic Package must be installed on the PC to perform diagnostics. If GDS was just installed, select: Add New Diagnostic Package and then select: a Diagnostic Package to download. 4. Click: On the GDS icon on the PC. 5. The Login Page will appear. 6. Select: A User. 7. The ID Screen will appear. 8. Select: The serial number of the MDI being used. 9. Select: Connect. 10. Verify that the system status is ready by observing for a flashing PC light icon on the MDI. 11. Select: Make, Model and Model Year, in order to build the vehicle. 12. Click: Upload VIN, to allow the VIN to be reported to the PC. 13. At: The Verification step, turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. 14. Select: Next Action. 15. The Home Page will appear. 16. Select: Next. 17. The Diagnostic Screen will appear. Note Due to vehicle build, software and RPO variations, GDS may ask for additional information in Step 18. 18. Select: Engine ID, if prompted. 19. Select: Module Diagnostics. 20. Select: ECM. 21. Select: ID Information. 22. The Diagnostics page will appear. Typical View of GDS Calibration History Screen Note GDS is capable of displaying up to 10 Calibration History events. 23. Select: Calibration History from the drop down menu in order to display the following items on the screen: - Calibration History Buffer - Number of Calibration History Events Stored - Calibration Part Number History - Calibration Verification Number History 24. Select: Screenshot. 25. Name and save the file in an appropriate folder. 26. Select : Print, and retain a copy of the screenshot with the repair order. 27. E-mail a copy of the screenshot to [email protected]. In the subject line of the e-mail include the phrase "V8 Cal" as well as the complete VIN and Dealer BAC. In the body of the e-mail, include the VIN, mileage, R.O. number and BAC. Include a brief description of the customer concern and cause of the concern. Page 2803 Window Switch - LR Page 3232 Page 5753 5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape. Seat Belt Schematic Icons Seat Belt Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons Page 1900 9. The illustration shows a cutaway view of the connector to aid the technician in releasing the terminal retainer. 10. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Terminal Position Assurance Locks TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Tyco/Amp Connectors (CM 42-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (CM 42-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the connector body and pull the CPA out. The CPA is on the wire harness side of connector. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 8884 Page 7462 Page 1877 TERMINAL REMOVAL Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors. 1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA) device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1). 3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 4. Gently pull the cable and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector. 5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal, refer to Terminal Repair. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3. Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector. REINSTALLING TERMINAL 1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly, refer to Wiring Repairs. 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3. Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) DELPHI CONNECTORS (WEATHER PACK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 1497 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert a small flat-blade tool in the slot below the front loaded terminal position assurance (TPA) and pry up. 3. Remove the TPA by pulling it out of the connector. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-553 (GM P/N 15315247) on a slight upward angle into the cavity below the terminal to be removed. Ensure that the pointed on the end of the tool is facing the bottom of the terminal and it stays in contact with the terminal until it stops on the plastic terminal retainer. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 1617 MOLEX CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. 2. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. Page 2145 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 7613 Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested: - Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. - Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a component or to other harnesses. - If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A TEST LAMP TOOLS REQUIRED J 35616-200 Test Light - Probe Kit NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminate even though voltage is present. The J 35616-200 is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair of leads. To properly operate this tool use the following procedures. When testing for voltage: 1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested. When testing for ground: 1. Attach one lead to battery positive voltage. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where ground should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is ground at the point being tested. Using Connector Test Adapters USING CONNECTOR TEST ADAPTERS NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Using Fused Jumper Wires USING FUSED JUMPER WIRES TOOLS REQUIRED J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged. The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested. AFL/ECP Connectors AFL/EPC CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Specifications Camshaft Gear/Sprocket: Specifications Camshaft Sprocket bolts First Pass tighten to ............................................................................................................................. ................................................... 75 N.m (55 lb ft) Final Pass tighten to ............................................. ........................................................................................................................................... 50 degrees Inspect the sprockets for proper alignment. The mark on the camshaft sprocket (1) should be located in the 6 o'clock position and the mark on the crankshaft sprocket (2) should be located in the 12 o'clock position. Page 7027 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. 4. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front of the connector. Page 1821 Oil Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Engine Oil Pressure Sensor and/or Switch Replacement Tools Required J 41712 Oil Pressure Switch Socket Removal Procedure 1. Remove the intake manifold. Refer to Intake Manifold Replacement. 2. Disconnect the oil pressure sensor electrical connector (1). 3. Using J 41712 or equivalent, remove the oil pressure sensor. Installation Procedure Page 3249 difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Bosch Connectors (ECM) BOSCH CONNECTORS (ECM) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the assist lever on the top of the connector. Move the assist lever to the forward position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 7795 REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. The release tab is located on the top of the wiredress cover. View of connector in released position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Page 4519 REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. The release tab is located on the top of the wiredress cover. View of connector in released position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Page 6632 For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 8525 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (BSK) BOSCH CONNECTORS (BSK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 3. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 4. Insert the J 38125-561 tool into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 5. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is Page 4514 The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors. 1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position. 4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool J 38125-10A (GM P/N 12014012-1) into the front (mating end) of the connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal through the back of the connector (2). IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector. 6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. 7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily. 10. Perform system check. Delphi Connectors (12 Way) DELPHI CONNECTORS (12-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. Page 4505 Depress the locks that are located on both sides of the wiredress cover and pull the lever over and past the locks. View of the connector when released from the component. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the front of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool push down on one of the locking tabs and pull the cover up until the dress cover releases. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. Page 4436 Release the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the blue locking tabs on both ends of the connector. Gently slide the TPA up to the released position on both ends. 6. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-13A (GM P/N 12031876-1) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. Page 7350 - Kostel - Molex - Sumitomo - Tyco/AMP - Yazaki Identifying the manufacturer of a connector is often difficult. When trying to determine the manufacturer of a connector, look for specific identifying marks that are unique to that connector supplier. Most of these identify marks are hard to find or see. Check the connector carefully and refer to the information below for pictures and descriptions of connector identification markings. - Most of AFLs connectors have EPC on their connector body. Some of the smaller connectors will not have any markings on them. - In some cases Bosch will actually be printed on the connector. If Bosch does not appear on the connector, look for the Bosch logo. The Bosch logo is a circle with a blunted arrow inside. This logo can appear anywhere on the connector and is often very small. Page 390 2. Locate the nose piece locking tabs that are positioned on the side of the connector nose piece. The connector nose piece acts as a terminal positive assurance (TPA) and may be referred to as such. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to push in one of the locking tabs while gently pulling on the same side of the nose piece. 4. Repeat the procedure for the other locking tab and remove the nose piece. 5. Remove the wire dress cover. The following is a general procedure for wire dress cover removal. Use this procedure as a guide, some dress cover removal procedures may vary. 6. Use fingers to squeeze the 2 locking legs of the cover. Page 3806 5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape. Seat Belt Schematic Icons Seat Belt Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons Page 8803 - Yazaki has a wedge or arrow shape, similar to that shown. Delphi Connectors (Micro .64) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro 64 connectors. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. The lever lock may be located on the top or sides of the wire dress cover. Page 2090 MEASURING FREQUENCY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal. IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM to autorange to an appropriate range. 1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency measured. Measuring Voltage MEASURING VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit. 1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods: - Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. - Turn ON the engine. - Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls. - Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested. 3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The DMM displays the voltage measured at that point. Measuring Voltage Drop MEASURING VOLTAGE DROP NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points. Probing Electrical Connectors PROBING ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS Page 4794 5. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove TPA from the connector. 6. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Page 1831 Service and Repair Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair SIR Disabling and Enabling SIR component location affects how a vehicle should be serviced. There are parts of the SIR system installed in various locations around a vehicle. To find the location of the SIR components refer to SIR Identification Views. There are several reasons for disabling the SIR system, such as repairs to the SIR system or servicing a component near or attached to an SIR component. There are several ways to disable the SIR system depending on what type of service is being performed. The following information covers the proper procedures for disabling/enabling the SIR system. SIR Service Precautions Caution: When performing service on or near the SIR components or the SIR wiring, the SIR system must be disabled. Failure to observe the correct procedure could cause deployment of the SIR components. Serious injury can occur. Failure to observe the correct procedure could also result in unnecessary SIR system repairs. The inflatable restraint sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) maintains a reserved energy supply. The reserved energy supply provides deployment power for the air bags if the SDM loses battery power during a collision. Deployment power is available for as much as 1 minute after disconnecting the vehicle power. Waiting 1 minute before working on the system after disabling the SIR system prevents deployment of the air bags from the reserved energy supply. General Service Instructions The following are general service instructions which must be followed in order to properly repair the vehicle and return it to its original integrity: * Do not expose inflator modules to temperatures above 65°C (150°F). * Verify the correct replacement part number. Do not substitute a component from a different vehicle. * Use only original GM replacement parts available from your authorized GM dealer. Do not use salvaged parts for repairs to the SIR system. Discard any of the following components if it has been dropped from a height of 91 cm (3 feet) or greater: * Inflatable restraint sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) * Any Inflatable restraint air bag module * Inflatable restraint steering wheel module coil * Any Inflatable restraint sensor * Inflatable restraint seat belt pretensioners * Inflatable restraint Passenger Presence System (PPS) module or sensor Disabling Procedure - Air Bag Fuse 1. Turn the steering wheel so that the vehicles wheels are pointing straight ahead. 2. Place the ignition in the OFF position. Important: The SDM may have more than one fused power input. To ensure there is no unwanted SIR deployment, personal injury, or unnecessary SIR system repairs, remove all fuses supplying power to the SDM. With all SDM fuses removed and the ignition switch in the ON position, the AIR BAG warning indicator illuminates. This is normal operation, and does not indicate a SIR system malfunction. 3. Locate and remove the fuse(s) supplying power to the SDM. Refer to SIR Schematics or Electrical Center Identification Views. 4. Wait 1 minute before working on the system. Enabling Procedure - Air Bag Fuse Page 8140 IMPORTANT: Ensure that the dress cover and connector body are both in the released position before reassembling. Failure to do so may cause damage to the connector and component. Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (0.64) BOSCH CONNECTORS (0.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While pressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock until the lever is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Pull the rubber boot that covers the wires back to expose the end of the connector dress cover. 4. Place the connector locking lever in the center of the connector. 5. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs that are on the wire end of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover and connector body and pry up. Page 8118 All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system. Page 106 Method 1 Method 2 Page 2386 2. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully push the terminal position assurance (TPA) towards the face of the connector on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA is fragile and may break if not done carefully. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. 3. Use the J 38125-215 tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 1609 4. Use a small flat-blade tool to slide the terminal position assurance (TPA) up one notch on both ends of the connector. The TPA is located underneath the wire dress cover. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 6756 Knock Sensor: Service and Repair Knock Sensor Replacement (Right Side) Knock Sensor Replacement (Right Side) Removal Procedure 1. Disconnect the electrical connector (3) from the knock sensor (2). 2. Remove the knock sensor bolt (1). 3. Remove the knock sensor (2) from the engine block. Installation Procedure 1. Position the knock sensor (2) on the engine block. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Install the knock sensor bolt (1). Tighten the bolt (1) to 20 N.m (15 lb ft). 3. Connect the electrical connector (3) to the knock sensor (2). Page 4040 Engine Oil Pressure: Testing and Inspection Oil Pressure Diagnosis and Testing Tools Required ^ EN-47971 Oil Pressure Gage Adapter ^ J 21867 Pressure Gage 1. With the vehicle on a level surface, run the vehicle for a few minutes, allow adequate drain down time, 2-3 minutes, and measure the oil level. 2. If required, add the recommended grade engine oil and fill the crankcase until the oil level measures full on the oil level indicator. 3. Run the engine briefly, 10-15 seconds, and verify low or no oil pressure on the vehicle gage or light. 4. Listen for a noisy valve train or a knocking noise. 5. Inspect for the following conditions: ^ Oil diluted by water or glycol antifreeze Refer to Coolant in Engine Oil. ^ Foamy oil, which may be caused by a cut or damaged oil pump screen O-ring seal 6. Remove the oil filter and install the EN-47971 (1). 7. Install the J 21867 (2), or equivalent to the EN-47971 (1). 8. Run the engine and measure the engine oil pressure. 9. Compare the readings to Engine Mechanical Specifications. 10. If the engine oil pressure is below specifications, inspect the engine for 1 or more of the following conditions: ^ Oil pump worn or dirty Refer to Oil Pump Cleaning and Inspection. ^ Oil pump-to-engine block bolts loose Refer to Oil Pump, Screen and Crankshaft Oil Deflector Installation. ^ Oil pump screen loose, plugged, or damaged ^ Oil pump screen O-ring seal missing or damaged ^ Oil filter tube loose or a leaking or damaged gasket ^ Malfunctioning oil pump pressure relief valve ^ Excessive bearing clearance ^ Cracked, porous, or restricted oil galleries ^ Oil gallery plugs missing or incorrectly installed Refer to Engine Block Plug Installation. ^ Improper operation of the active fuel management oil pressure relief valve Refer to Cylinder Deactivation (Active Fuel Management) Oil Pressure Relief Valve Diagnosis and Testing. Page 4977 5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape. Seat Belt Schematic Icons Seat Belt Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons Page 2859 Alignment: Service and Repair Trim Height Inspection Trim Height Inspection Trim Height Measurements Trim height is a predetermined measurement relating to vehicle ride height. Incorrect trim heights can cause bottoming out over bumps, damage to suspension components, and symptoms similar to wheel alignment problems. Inspect the trim heights when diagnosing suspension concerns and before inspecting the wheel alignment. Perform the following prior to measuring trim heights: ^ Make sure the vehicle is on a level surface, such as an alignment rack. ^ Set the tire pressures to specifications. Refer to Vehicle Certification, Tire Place Card, Anti-Theft, and Service Parts ID Label. ^ Check the fuel level. Add additional weight if necessary to simulate a full tank. ^ To ensure proper weight distribution, make sure the rear storage compartment is empty. ^ Close the doors and hood. Z Height Measurement The Z height measurement determines the proper ride height for the front end of the vehicle. Vehicles equipped with torsion bars use an adjusting arm to adjust the Z height. Vehicles without torsion bars have no adjustment and may require replacement of suspension components. Important: All dimensions are measured vertical to the ground. Cross vehicle Z heights should be within 24 mm (0.9 in). 1. Place hands on the front bumper and jounce the front of the vehicle. Make sure that there is at least 38 mm (1.5 in) of movement while jouncing. 2. Allow the vehicle to settle into position. 3. Measure from the centerline (1) of the lower control arm bushing bolt (4) down to the machined edge of the steering knuckle (2) in order to obtain Z height measurement (3). 4. Repeat the jouncing operation and measurement 2 more times for a total of 3 times. 5. Use the highest and lowest measurements to calculate the average height. 6. The true Z height dimension number is the average of the high and the low measurements. Refer to Trim Height Specifications. 7. If these measurements are out of specifications, inspect for the following conditions: ^ Sagging front suspension-Refer to Shock Module Replacement. ^ Collision damage D Height Measurement The D height measurement determines the proper ride height for the rear end of the vehicle. There is no adjustment procedure. Repair may require replacement of suspension components. Important: All dimensions are measured vertical to the ground. Cross vehicle D heights should be within 12 mm (0.5 in) for vehicles equipped with coil springs. Vehicles equipped with air suspension should be within 8 mm (0.3 in). Page 7792 Release the lower wiredress cover locking tab. Release the upper wiredress cover locking tab. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. Page 2268 3. Ensure that the terminal release tang access panel is in the correct location to access the terminals. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) into the terminal release tang access slot located behind the access panel of the connector and press down on the terminal while carefully pulling the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Tyco/AMP Connectors (0.25 Cap) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (025 CAP) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component by pressing down on the connector position assurance (CPA). Page 5526 MEASURING FREQUENCY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal. IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM to autorange to an appropriate range. 1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency measured. Measuring Voltage MEASURING VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit. 1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods: - Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. - Turn ON the engine. - Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls. - Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested. 3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The DMM displays the voltage measured at that point. Measuring Voltage Drop MEASURING VOLTAGE DROP NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points. Probing Electrical Connectors PROBING ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS Page 8300 2. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 1638 2. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully push the terminal position assurance (TPA) towards the face of the connector on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA is fragile and may break if not done carefully. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. 3. Use the J 38125-215 tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 7066 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry one side of the nose piece up to the pre-stage position. When the nose piece is in the pre-staged position, the nose piece will be raised above the connector body the length of the step in the nose piece. 7. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry the other side of the piece to the pre-stage position. If the nose piece is higher than the first step in the nose piece, gently push down on the nose piece until it meets with resistance from the connector body, you should feel the nose piece click into position. Page 7107 Important: Before installing the camshaft sensor assembly, apply a small amount of clean motor oil to the O-ring (6). 4. Install the camshaft position sensor assembly (4, 5, 6) in the front cover (7). Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 5. Install the camshaft position sensor mounting bolts. Tighten the camshaft position mounting bolts 25 N.m (18 lb ft). 6. Install the generator assembly. Page 6383 If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs SIR/SRS WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS, and the wiring components, such as connectors and terminals. IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system terminals. Use either an SIR/SRS pigtail or a terminated lead from the SIR Repair Kit Tray. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves, in order to repair the SIR/SRS wiring - A special crimping tool - A heat torch - An instruction manual The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides the necessary low resistance contact integrity for these sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors SIR/SRS CONNECTOR REPAIR (PLASTIC BODY AND TERMINAL METAL PIN) The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made with a special plating. This plating provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. Use the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit for repairing SIR/SRS terminals and connectors. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the repair kit. The J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit contains: Various terminated leads for sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) terminal replacement - Various connector positive assurance (CPA) locks for SIR/SRS connectors - Base of steering column pigtail connectors part number 12085514 - Yellow vinyl electrical tape Pigtail repair packs are available for SIR/SRS connectors with eight or less terminals. Only the connector body is available for connectors with more than eight terminals. The terminated leads in the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit can be used to replace damaged terminals when replacing the connector body. SIR/SRS COMPONENT WIRE PIGTAIL REPAIR IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails. A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device, not by a connector. If a wiring pigtail is damaged, you must replace the entire component, with pigtail. The inflatable restraint steering wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component. SIR/SRS WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 6524 Checking Aftermarket Accessories CHECKING AFTERMARKET ACCESSORIES Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits: - CAUTION: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol. - NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice. OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol. Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the cause of the problems. Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include: Power feeds connected to points other than the battery - Antenna location - Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring - Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line - Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories. Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions INDUCING INTERMITTENT FAULT CONDITIONS TOOLS REQUIRED J 25070 Heat Gun Many intermittent open or shorted circuits are affected by harness/connector movement that is caused by vibration, engine torque, bumps/rough pavement, etc. In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness if the malfunction appears to be Page 639 8. Take a CLEAR digital picture of the Tech 2(R) Vehicle Information screen showing the engine Calibration IDs and Verification Numbers as shown above. Retain the printout information and the Tech 2(R) screen photograph with the repair order. Note All pictures must be sent as a.jpg file. 9. E-mail a copy of the picture to [email protected]. In the subject line of the e-mail include the phrase "V8 Cal" as well as the complete VIN and Dealer BAC. In the body of the e-mail, include the VIN, mileage, R.O. number and BAC. Include a brief description of the customer concern and cause of the concern. Note The dealer will receive an e-mail reply after the calibrations have been validated. The e-mail reply will advise the dealer if the calibrations are OEM. 10. Allow two hours for the PQC to verify the calibrations and set up the case details. ‹› If the PQC determines that the calibrations ARE aftermarket calibrations, DO NOT contact GM Technical Assistance to discuss warranty concerns on the aftermarket calibrations. ALL questions and concerns about warranty should be directed to the dealers Fixed Operations Manager (FOM), (Warranty Manager (WM) in Canada). 11. You may call the PQC two hours after submitting the e-mail for authorization to replace the assembly. This will provide them time to receive, review and set up a case on the request. Please be prepared to provide all the usual documentation that is normally required when requesting an assembly authorization from the PQC. Tech 2(R) Displaying All Zeroes for the Verification Numbers on the Calibration ID and Verification Number Screen If the Tech 2(R) that you are using displays all zeroes for the Verification Numbers as shown, then perform the following steps: 1. Update the Tech 2(R) with the latest software from TIS2WEB. 2. Turn OFF the ignition for 90 seconds. 3. Connect the Tech 2(R) to the vehicle. 4. Turn ON the ignition, and build the vehicle. Observe the Tech 2(R) Calibration ID and Verification Number screen for proper operation. ‹› If the Tech 2(R) screen still does not display properly, then turn OFF the ignition for 90 seconds again. Turn ON the ignition and observe the same screen for proper operation. Retrieving Calibrations From a Global A Vehicle This information applies to the 2010 Camaro and is typical of the procedure that will be used on Global A vehicles. 1. Turn OFF the ignition. Page 8395 11. Insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) into the 2 triangular cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 12. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE 1. Prior to installation the terminal must be aligned so the (1) coding lugs align with the (2) coding grooves on the connector. 2. Once the terminal is aligned, slide the terminal into the cavity until the retainer has engaged in the cavity of the connector. 3. Slide the TPA in the connector body and seat it using a small flat bladed tool. The TPA is seated when it is flush with the contact housing. 4. Secure the wires to the connector body using a tie wrap and replace the dress cover and grommet. Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) BOSCH CONNECTORS (2.8 JPT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Pull out the slider on the connector position assurance (CPA) until it is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. OnStar(R) - Re-establishing OnStar(R) Communications Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Re-establishing OnStar(R) Communications Bulletin No.: 00-08-46-004C Date: January 17, 2008 INFORMATION Subject: Re-establishing Communications with OnStar(R) Center After Battery Disconnect Models: 2000-2008 GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn and Saab) with Digital OnStar(R) (RPO UE1) Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 00-08-46-004B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories). When servicing any of the above models and a battery cable is disconnected or power to the OnStar(R) Vehicle Communication Interface Module (VCIM) is interrupted for any reason the following procedure must be performed to verify proper Global Positioning System (GPS) function. Never swap OnStar(R) Vehicle Communication Interface Modules (VCIM) from other vehicles. Transfer of OnStar(R) modules from other vehicles should not be done. Each OnStar(R) module has a unique identification number. The VCIM has a specific Station Identification (STID). This identification number is used by the National Cellular Telephone Network and OnStar(R) systems and is stored in General Motors Vehicle History files by VIN. After completing ALL repairs to the vehicle you must perform the following procedure: Move the vehicle into an open area of the service lot. Sit in the vehicle with the engine running and the radio turned on for five minutes. Press the OnStar(R) button in the vehicle. When the OnStar(R) advisor answers ask the advisor to verify the current location of the vehicle. If the vehicle location is different than the location the OnStar(R) advisor gives contact GM Technical Assistance (TAC) and choose the OnStar(R) prompt. GM OnStar(R) TAC will assist in the diagnosis of a failed VCIM and, if appropriate, order a replacement part. Replacement parts are usually shipped out within 24 hours, and a pre-paid return package label will be included for returning the faulty part. By returning the faulty part, you will avoid a non-return core charge. Disclaimer Page 5145 Page 7116 under pressure if the radiator cap or the surge tank cap is removed while the engine and radiator are still hot. 4. Remove the surge tank fill cap from the surge tank or the coolant pressure cap from the radiator. 5. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle in SI. 6. Place a clean drain pan under the radiator drain cock or under the lower radiator hose depending on the vehicle. Refer to Cooling System Draining and Filling in SI. 7. Loosen the radiator drain cock if equipped or use J 38185 clamp pliers and reposition the clamp on the lower radiator hose at the radiator. 8. Remove the end of the lower radiator hose from the radiator. 9. Drain the engine coolant sufficiently below the level of the ECT sensor. 10. Close the radiator drain cock or connect the lower radiator hose at the radiator. 11. Use the J 38185 clamp pliers to place the clamp into the original position on the hose. 12. Lower the vehicle. 13. Disconnect the wiring harness connector from the ECT sensor (2). 14. Remove the ECT sensor (1) from the front of the cylinder head. 15. Remove the corresponding size plug at the rear of the OTHER cylinder head. 16. Coat the threads of the ECT sensor with sealer. Use GM P/N 12346004 (Canadian P/N 10953480) or an equivalent. 17. Install the ECT sensor in the hole of the cylinder head where the plug was removed. Tighten Tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb ft). 18. Coat the threads of the plug with sealer. Use GM P/N 12346004 (Canadian P/N 10953480) or an equivalent. 19. Install the plug in the hole of the cylinder head where the ECT sensor was removed Tighten Tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb ft). Important Leave enough wire attached to the ECT sensor harness connector in order to create manageable splices that are at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splice. Page 2024 5. Once the nose piece retainers are relaxed, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should raise slightly. 6. On the opposite side of the nose piece, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should release completely. If the nose piece does not come off, repeat the procedure on the opposite side. Page 303 Power Seat Control Module: Diagrams Memory Seat Module - Driver C4 Memory Seat Module - Driver C4 (w/Memory) Page 7030 6. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs located on the opposite side of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover at the connector end and pry up. 7. Remove the dress cover. 8. Cut the tie wrap on the wire bundle. 9. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting a small flat-bladed tool into the small slot in the end of the slider and pushing on the TPA until it comes out of the connector. When the TPA exits the opposite side of the connector, gasp the TPA and pull it completely out of the connector. 10. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 826 Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. For connectors with a bolt in the dress cover, turn the bolt counterclockwise to remove the connector from the component. 2. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. Page 7340 Release the tabs that are holding the wiredress cover to the connector body. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the slots on both ends of the connector body. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. J 38125-216 can also be used to remove the nose piece. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by lifting the terminal retaining tabs on the inside of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 5363 breakers are used. CIRCUIT BREAKER This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high current is removed. POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) CIRCUIT BREAKER This type greatly increases its resistance when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker will re-close within a second or 2. Circuit Protection - Fuses CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSES The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and examine the element in the fuse for an open (2). If not broken (1), also check for continuity using a DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one of equal current rating. Circuit Protection - Fusible Links CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSIBLE LINKS Page 1554 Page 7064 MOLEX CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. 2. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. Page 8381 If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200 DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J 39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected. IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J 39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and maximum (MAX) values measured. 1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of a suspected circuit to the other. 2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J 39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep). IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value in order to record the full change. 5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling the connections or the wiring, test driving, or performing other operations. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions. 6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9. Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist. Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections TESTING FOR INTERMITTENT CONDITIONS AND POOR CONNECTIONS TOOLS REQUIRED - J 35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit - J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit When the condition is not currently present, but is indicated in DTC history, the cause may be intermittent. An intermittent may also be the cause when there is a customer complaint, but the symptom cannot be duplicated. Refer to the Symptom Table of the system that is suspect of causing the condition before trying to locate an intermittent condition. Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the following items: Wiring broken inside the insulation - Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector - Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself, and corrosion in the wire to terminal contact area, etc. - Pierced or damaged insulation can allow moisture to enter the wiring causing corrosion. The conductor can corrode inside the insulation, with little visible evidence. Look for swollen and stiff sections of wire in the suspect circuits. - Wiring which has been pinched, cut, or its insulation rubbed through may cause an intermittent open or short as the bare area touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle. - Wiring that comes in contact with hot or exhaust components - Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required, in order to verify the customer concern. - Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. - Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis and Vehicle Data Recorder operation. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any inline connectors before replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation. Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination, usually in the underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit. Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper adapter. Always use the J 35616 when probing connectors. Other causes of terminal deformation are improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT IN BUSSED ELECTRICAL CENTERS (BEC) Page 6032 Oxygen Sensor: Connector Views Engine Controls Connector End Views Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Bank 1 Sensor 1 Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Bank 1 Sensor 2 Page 3787 View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. View of the release tool being used for the smaller terminals. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (2-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 1597 The first connector design of the Micro-Pack 100W (1) has a white connector interface that holds the terminals. The second design of the Micro-Pack 100W (2) has a gray interface to hold the terminals. Also, the first design has terminal cavities that are further apart (3 mm centerline) and offset from the other row of terminal cavities in the connector. The second design has terminals cavities that are closer together (2.54 mm centerline) and aligned vertically. One other way to identify the second design is the thin strip of material that runs along the outside of the cavities. IMPORTANT: There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W terminals which are very similar. Ensure that you have the correct terminal before crimping the new terminal to the wire. The first design connector uses the longer terminal (1) that has a raised area in front of the recess in the terminal. The second design connector uses the shorter terminal without the raised area. Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro-Pack 100W connectors. Some Micro-Pack 100W connector disassembly procedures will vary. Use this procedure as a guide. 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 7964 Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate labor operation for the source of the water leak Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 8207 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the DuraSeal splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of a connector. CPAs are used in all SIR System connectors and also in some connectors of other systems. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals of a connection. TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE CLIPS IMPORTANT: When making a splice in an area that may be exposed to moisture use a crimp and seal splice sleeve instead of a Splice Clip. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. Page 3864 4. Connect the electrical connector to the oil pressure sensor. 5. Install the intake manifold. Refer to Intake Manifold Replacement. Page 3749 The first connector design of the Micro-Pack 100W (1) has a white connector interface that holds the terminals. The second design of the Micro-Pack 100W (2) has a gray interface to hold the terminals. Also, the first design has terminal cavities that are further apart (3 mm centerline) and offset from the other row of terminal cavities in the connector. The second design has terminals cavities that are closer together (2.54 mm centerline) and aligned vertically. One other way to identify the second design is the thin strip of material that runs along the outside of the cavities. IMPORTANT: There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W terminals which are very similar. Ensure that you have the correct terminal before crimping the new terminal to the wire. The first design connector uses the longer terminal (1) that has a raised area in front of the recess in the terminal. The second design connector uses the shorter terminal without the raised area. Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro-Pack 100W connectors. Some Micro-Pack 100W connector disassembly procedures will vary. Use this procedure as a guide. 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 8713 7. Pressing the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool in the release cavity of the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and crimper in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (DOOR MODULE) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Side view of connector. View of top of connector. 1. Locate the assist lever and lock on the top of the connector. Page 2208 It is very important to use the correct test adapter when testing for proper terminal contact of fuses and relays in a bussed electrical center (BEC). Use J-35616-35 to test for proper terminal contact. Failure to use J-35616-35 can result in improper diagnosis of the BEC. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Separate the connector halves. 2. Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body. 3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J-38125 , test that the retention force is significantly different between a good terminal and a suspect terminal. Replace the female terminal in question. FLAT WIRE (DOCK AND LOCK) CONNECTORS There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock) connectors on the harness side or the component side. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Remove the component in question. 2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side of the connector as oil from your skin may be a source of contamination as well. 3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other imperfections that could cause poor terminal contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are uniform and free of damage or deformation. 4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the on the flat wire harness connector in order to test the circuit in question. CONTROL MODULE/COMPONENT VOLTAGE AND GROUNDS Poor voltage or ground connections can cause widely varying symptoms. Test all control module voltage supply circuits. Many vehicles have multiple circuits supplying voltage to a control module. Other components in the system may have separate voltage supply circuits that may also need to be tested. Inspect connections at the module/component connectors, fuses, and any intermediate connections between the voltage source and the module/component. A test lamp or a DMM may indicate that voltage is present, but neither tests the ability of the circuit to carry sufficient current. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Power Distribution Schematics. - Test all control module ground and system ground circuits. The control module may have multiple ground circuits. Other components in the system may have separate grounds that may also need to be tested. Inspect grounds for clean and tight connections at the grounding point. Inspect the connections at the component and in splice packs, where applicable. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Ground Distribution Schematics. TEMPERATURE SENSITIVITY - An intermittent condition may occur when a component/connection reaches normal operating temperature. The condition may occur only when the component/connection is cold, or only when the component/connection is hot. - Freeze Frame, Failure Records, Snapshot, or Vehicle Data Recorder data may help with this type of intermittent condition, where applicable. - If the intermittent is related to heat, review the data for a relationship with the following: High ambient temperatures - Underhood/engine generated heat - Circuit generated heat due to a poor connection, or high electrical load - Higher than normal load conditions, towing, etc. - If the intermittent is related to cold, review the data for the following: Low ambient temperatures-In extremely low temperatures, ice may form in a connection or component. Inspect for water intrusion. - The condition only occurs on a cold start. - The condition goes away when the vehicle warms up. - Information from the customer may help to determine if the trouble follows a pattern that is temperature related. - If temperature is suspected of causing an intermittent fault condition, attempt to duplicate the condition. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required. ELECTROMAGNETIC INTERFERENCE (EMI) AND ELECTRICAL NOISE Some electrical components/circuits are sensitive to electromagnetic interference (EMI) or other types of electrical noise. Inspect for the following conditions: A misrouted harness that is too close to high voltage/high current devices such as secondary ignition components, motors, generator etc-These components may induce electrical noise on a circuit that could interfere with normal circuit operation. - Electrical system interference caused by a malfunctioning relay, or a control module driven solenoid or switch-These conditions can cause a sharp electrical surge. Normally, the condition will occur when the malfunctioning component is operating. - Improper installation of non-factory or aftermarket add on accessories such as lights, 2-way radios, amplifiers, electric motors, remote starters, alarm systems, cell phones, etc-These accessories may lead to interference while in use, but do not fail when the accessories are not in use. - Test for an open diode across the A/C compressor clutch and for other open diodes. Some relays may contain a clamping diode. - The generator may be allowing AC noise into the electrical system. INCORRECT CONTROL MODULE - There are only a few situations where reprogramming a control module is appropriate: A new service control module is installed. Page 3925 Notice: Refer to Component Fastener Tightening Notice. 3. Install the coolant heater to the engine block. Tighten the coolant heater to 50 N.m (37 lb ft). 4. Install the coolant heater cord to the heater (2). 5. Properly position the engine electrical harness bracket to the intake manifold. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 6. Install the engine electrical harness bracket bolt. Tighten the bolt to 10 N.m (89 lb in). Locations Horn Relay: Locations Fuse Block - Underhood (5.3L/6.0L), Label Page 7193 Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. FCI Connectors FCI CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 8710 7. The illustration above identifies the entry canal where the terminal release tool will be inserted, and the terminal cavity. - Terminal (1) - Entry Canal (2) 8. Insert the J-38125-553 (15315247) tool into the entry canal and pry up on the terminal retainer. The terminal retainer is a small plastic piece on the top of the terminal. The terminal retainer must be held up while the terminal is pulled out of the connector. Page 6241 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. 4. Remove the dress cover by using a flat bladed tool to release the dress cover locking tabs and lift up on the dress cover. 5. Cut the tie wrap that holds the wires to the connector body. Page 8568 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 3030 Disclaimer Page 8183 9. The illustration shows a cutaway view of the connector to aid the technician in releasing the terminal retainer. 10. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Terminal Position Assurance Locks TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Tyco/Amp Connectors (CM 42-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (CM 42-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the connector body and pull the CPA out. The CPA is on the wire harness side of connector. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 5902 Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Diagrams Engine Controls Connector End Views Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor Locations Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Locations Engine Controls Component Views Accelerator and Brake Pedals 1 - Instrument Panel Harness 2 - Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor 3 - Accelerator Pedal 4 Brake Pedal 5 - Stop Lamp Switch Page 7675 View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. View of the release tool being used for the smaller terminals. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (2-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 9052 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. JST Connectors JST CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, remove the connector from the component. Page 2420 Utility/Van Zoning UTILITY/VAN ZONING Page 1773 6. Gently pry the plastic terminal retainer down and carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (16-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, pull the two connector halves apart. Page 5619 Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Camshaft Position Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Remove the generator bracket assembly. 2. Remove the camshaft position sensor mounting bolts (1). 3. Remove the camshaft position sensor assembly (4, 5, 6) from the front cover (7). 4. Disconnect the camshaft position sensor jumper harness (2) and the engine harness (3) electrical connectors. 5. Remove the camshaft sensor assembly (4, 5, 6). 6. Disconnect camshaft position sensor (5) from the jumper harness (4). Installation Procedure 1. Reconnect the camshaft sensor (5) and the jumper harness (4). 2. Install the O-ring (6) on the camshaft sensor assembly (4, 5). 3. Reconnect the camshaft position sensor assembly (4, 5, 6) and the engine harness connector (3). Page 6639 Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair Key and Lock Cylinder Coding Use Instruction Sheet Supplied For the lock cylinder coding procedure, refer to the instruction sheet supplied in the lock cylinder kit. For key cutting information, refer to the instructions provided from the manufacturer of the key cutting equipment used. Page 3907 under pressure if the radiator cap or the surge tank cap is removed while the engine and radiator are still hot. 4. Remove the surge tank fill cap from the surge tank or the coolant pressure cap from the radiator. 5. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle in SI. 6. Place a clean drain pan under the radiator drain cock or under the lower radiator hose depending on the vehicle. Refer to Cooling System Draining and Filling in SI. 7. Loosen the radiator drain cock if equipped or use J 38185 clamp pliers and reposition the clamp on the lower radiator hose at the radiator. 8. Remove the end of the lower radiator hose from the radiator. 9. Drain the engine coolant sufficiently below the level of the ECT sensor. 10. Close the radiator drain cock or connect the lower radiator hose at the radiator. 11. Use the J 38185 clamp pliers to place the clamp into the original position on the hose. 12. Lower the vehicle. 13. Disconnect the wiring harness connector from the ECT sensor (2). 14. Remove the ECT sensor (1) from the front of the cylinder head. 15. Remove the corresponding size plug at the rear of the OTHER cylinder head. 16. Coat the threads of the ECT sensor with sealer. Use GM P/N 12346004 (Canadian P/N 10953480) or an equivalent. 17. Install the ECT sensor in the hole of the cylinder head where the plug was removed. Tighten Tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb ft). 18. Coat the threads of the plug with sealer. Use GM P/N 12346004 (Canadian P/N 10953480) or an equivalent. 19. Install the plug in the hole of the cylinder head where the ECT sensor was removed Tighten Tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb ft). Important Leave enough wire attached to the ECT sensor harness connector in order to create manageable splices that are at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splice. Page 5847 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully raise the TPA on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA cannot be removed from the connector while there are terminals present in the connector body. View of the TPA when removed from the connector body. 4. Use the J 38125-12A tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the left side of the terminal release cavity as shown in the graphic. Use the tool to move the terminal release to the right with a gentle prying motion. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 864 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully raise the TPA on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA cannot be removed from the connector while there are terminals present in the connector body. View of the TPA when removed from the connector body. 4. Use the J 38125-12A tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the left side of the terminal release cavity as shown in the graphic. Use the tool to move the terminal release to the right with a gentle prying motion. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Engine - MIL ON P0116/P1400 Set In Very Cold Temps Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - MIL ON P0116/P1400 Set In Very Cold Temps TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 10-06-04-008A Date: January 24, 2011 Subject: Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) Illuminated at Very Cold Ambient Temperatures When Using Engine Coolant Heater, DTC P0116 and/or P1400 Set (Relocate Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor and Engine Coolant Heater Cord) Models: 2006-2007 Buick Rainier 2009 Buick LaCrosse Super, Allure Super (Canada Only) 2006-2010 Cadillac Escalade 2006-2007 Chevrolet Monte Carlo 2006-2009 Chevrolet Impala SS, TrailBlazer 2006-2010 Chevrolet Avalanche, Express, Silverado Tahoe 2006-2009 GMC Envoy 2006-2010 GMC Savana, Sierra, Yukon 2006-2008 Pontiac Grand Prix 2006-2009 Saab 9-7X Equipped with V8 Engine RPO LC9, LH6, LH8, LH9, L76, LS2, LS4, LFA, LZ1, L92, L94, L9H or L20, L96, LMF, LMG, LY2, LY5, LY6 Please Refer to GMVIS Attention: To properly correct this condition, you must follow both of the procedures to relocate the ECT sensor and the engine coolant heater cord. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add cast iron block engine RPOs and to update the Warranty Information coverage period. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 10-06-04-008 (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). Condition Some customers may comment that the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) illuminates after starting the vehicle when they were using the engine coolant heater in very cold ambient temperatures. This usually occurs in a range of -23 to -40°C (-10 to -40°F) or colder. The technician may observe on a scan tool DTC P0116 and/or P1400 set as Current or in History. Cause This condition may be caused by the engine control module (ECM) determining that the ignition OFF time requirement has been met at start-up and interpreting the temperature difference between the engine coolant temperature (ECT) sensor and the intake air temperature (IAT) sensor as being outside of a calibrated range. Correction Important DO NOT replace the ECM for this condition. Relocating the ECT Sensor 1. Turn ON the ignition with the engine OFF. 2. Perform the diagnostic system check - vehicle. Refer to Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle in SI. ‹› If DTC P0116 and/or P1400 are set and the customer WAS using the engine coolant heater, proceed to Step 3. ‹› If DTC P0116 and/or P1400 are set and the customer WAS NOT using the engine coolant heater, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle in SI. 3. Turn OFF the ignition. Warning To avoid being burned, do not remove the radiator cap or surge tank cap while the engine is hot. The cooling system will release scalding fluid and steam Page 39 Disclaimer Page 705 - JST connectors have JST in small letters on their connectors, similar to that above. The location of the logo will vary with the connector size and style. - Kostel has an "LK" with a circle around it. These connector are usually used as a transmissions connection and are currently use on some Cadillac vehicles. Page 5200 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Kostal Connectors KOSTAL CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Diagram Information and Instructions Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions Electrical Symbols Underhood Fuse Block Fuse: Application and ID Underhood Fuse Block Fuse Block - Underhood (5.3L/6.0L), Label Page 5836 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Ensure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the Terminal Removal Procedure. Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PULL TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL If the terminal is visibly damaged or is suspected of having a faulty connection, the terminal should be replaced. Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors: 1. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) device and/or the secondary lock. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component or separate the connectors for in-line connectors. 3. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device. 4. Insert the proper pick or removal tool into the front of the connector body. 5. IMPORTANT: On connectors with more than one terminal the service loop may not be large enough to remove the terminal and crimp on a new one. If the terminal wire does not have a large enough service loop for removal, cut the wire 5 cm (2 in) behind the connector before removal. Grasp the wire at the back of the connector body and gently push the terminal out the front of the connector body. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. If the wire needed to be cut in order to remove the terminal, gently push a small length of the same size wire through the back of the connector cavity until there is enough wire exposed in order to crimp on a new terminal. If the wire was not cut, cut the existing wire as close to the old terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 4. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. TERMINAL INSTALLATION 1. Align the terminal and pull the wire from the back of the connector in order to seat the terminal. 2. If necessary, cut the new wire to proper length and splice with existing circuit. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. 3. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply dielectric grease to the connector. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PUSH TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 7698 Knock Sensor: Connector Views Engine Controls Connector End Views Knock Sensor (KS) 1 - Left Knock Sensor (KS) 2 - Right Page 5965 - Yazaki has a wedge or arrow shape, similar to that shown. Delphi Connectors (Micro .64) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro 64 connectors. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. The lever lock may be located on the top or sides of the wire dress cover. Page 5328 Release the lower wiredress cover locking tab. Release the upper wiredress cover locking tab. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. Page 1985 11. Insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) into the 2 triangular cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 12. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE 1. Prior to installation the terminal must be aligned so the (1) coding lugs align with the (2) coding grooves on the connector. 2. Once the terminal is aligned, slide the terminal into the cavity until the retainer has engaged in the cavity of the connector. 3. Slide the TPA in the connector body and seat it using a small flat bladed tool. The TPA is seated when it is flush with the contact housing. 4. Secure the wires to the connector body using a tie wrap and replace the dress cover and grommet. Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) BOSCH CONNECTORS (2.8 JPT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Pull out the slider on the connector position assurance (CPA) until it is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 4481 If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200 DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J 39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected. IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J 39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and maximum (MAX) values measured. 1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of a suspected circuit to the other. 2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J 39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep). IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value in order to record the full change. 5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling the connections or the wiring, test driving, or performing other operations. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions. 6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9. Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist. Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections TESTING FOR INTERMITTENT CONDITIONS AND POOR CONNECTIONS TOOLS REQUIRED - J 35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit - J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit When the condition is not currently present, but is indicated in DTC history, the cause may be intermittent. An intermittent may also be the cause when there is a customer complaint, but the symptom cannot be duplicated. Refer to the Symptom Table of the system that is suspect of causing the condition before trying to locate an intermittent condition. Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the following items: Wiring broken inside the insulation - Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector - Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself, and corrosion in the wire to terminal contact area, etc. - Pierced or damaged insulation can allow moisture to enter the wiring causing corrosion. The conductor can corrode inside the insulation, with little visible evidence. Look for swollen and stiff sections of wire in the suspect circuits. - Wiring which has been pinched, cut, or its insulation rubbed through may cause an intermittent open or short as the bare area touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle. - Wiring that comes in contact with hot or exhaust components - Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required, in order to verify the customer concern. - Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. - Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis and Vehicle Data Recorder operation. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any inline connectors before replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation. Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination, usually in the underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit. Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper adapter. Always use the J 35616 when probing connectors. Other causes of terminal deformation are improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT IN BUSSED ELECTRICAL CENTERS (BEC) Page 2320 - A control module from another vehicle is installed. - Revised software/calibration files have been released for this vehicle. - IMPORTANT: DO NOT re-program the control module with the SAME software/calibration files that are already present in the control module. This is not an effective repair for any type of concern. Verify that the control module contains the correct software/calibration. If incorrect programming is found, reprogram the control module with the most current software/calibration. Refer to Control Module References for replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Testing for Short to Ground TESTING FOR SHORT TO GROUND NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 4. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit. With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is a short to ground in the circuit. Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2. Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). - When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. - If the DMM does not display voltage 4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is shorted. Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A DIGITAL MULTIMETER NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the powertrain control module (PCM), should only be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200 Digital Multimeter (DMM). The J 39200 instruction manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminage even though voltage is present. The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity. IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading. Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the measurement. Page 8801 - JST connectors have JST in small letters on their connectors, similar to that above. The location of the logo will vary with the connector size and style. - Kostel has an "LK" with a circle around it. These connector are usually used as a transmissions connection and are currently use on some Cadillac vehicles. Page 5216 4. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the rear of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. 5. Once the locking tabs are unlocked, slide the inner connector out of the rear of the connector housing. Page 7390 7. Pressing the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool in the release cavity of the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and crimper in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (DOOR MODULE) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Side view of connector. View of top of connector. 1. Locate the assist lever and lock on the top of the connector. Page 6378 If a wire is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm, etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except coaxial. - Do not use the DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent American wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 8653 IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals. Front probe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the connector. IMPORTANT: When probing female 0.64 terminals, it is important to use the correct adapter. There have been some revisions to the test adapter for 0.64 terminals. The proper adapter for 0.64 terminals is the J 35616-64B which has a gold terminal and a black wire between the base and tip. Failure to use the proper test adapter may result in damage to the terminal being tested and improper diagnosis. NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Page 5427 5. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove TPA from the connector. 6. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Page 8330 Camshaft Position Sensor: Connector Views Engine Controls Connector End Views Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor Page 258 Open the harness by removing any tape. 2. Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. 3. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 4. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent american wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 5. Slide a section of high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing down the length of wire to be spliced. Ensure that the shrink tubing will not interfere with the splice procedure. 6. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 7. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. 8. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 9. Insert the wire into the DuraSeal splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 10. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Page 4731 3. Radiator outlet hose (lower hose) to engine (3). (Shown as viewed from below.) 4. Radiator outlet hose (lower hose) to radiator (4). (Shown as viewed from below.) 5. Heater inlet hose to engine (5). Page 1964 Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Page 676 All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system. Page 6586 3. Use a small flat-bladed tool to gently pry off the dress cover by inserting the tool under the cover opposite the harness side and prying up. 4. Remove the cover. 5. Using a small flat-bladed tool, push on the side of the nose piece retainer while pushing the nose piece forward with your thumb. This will release the terminal position assurance (TPA). 6. Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) into the corresponding terminal release cavity. The release cavities are the 2 center rows of cavities on one half of the connector. Page 6928 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. 4. Remove the dress cover by using a flat bladed tool to release the dress cover locking tabs and lift up on the dress cover. 5. Cut the tie wrap that holds the wires to the connector body. Page 555 6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias. Reference the appropriate service manual wiring schematic to obtain the correct diode installation position. 7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for the soldering equipment. 8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed. 9. IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode attachment points with tape. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape. Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable SPLICING TWISTED OR SHIELDED CABLE Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable. 1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splice is made. 3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire. Staggering the splices by 65 mm (2.5 in) is recommended. 4. IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical contact with the drain wire. Re-assemble the cable. Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape. - Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1). - Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire. - Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape. Page 3238 Refer to the following table as a guide in selecting the correct test adapter for front probing connectors: Backprobe IMPORTANT: Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures. - Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector. - Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large of a test probe. - After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected, test for proper terminal contact. Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the connector. Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure SCAN TOOL SNAPSHOT PROCEDURE Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used Page 5144 Page 5023 Tighten the nut to 10 N.m (89 lb in). 4. Install the hose to the throttle body. 5. Using J 38185, position the throttle body hose clamp at the throttle body. 6. Install the inlet and outlet hoses/pipes to the water pump. 7. Using J 38185, position the auxiliary heater inlet and outlet hose/pipe clamps at the water pump. 8. Install the outlet hose to the water pump. 9. Using J 38185, position the outlet hose clamp at the water pump. 10. Install the inlet hose to the water pump. 11. Using J 38185, position the inlet hose clamp at the water pump. 12. Install the cooing fan and shroud. Refer to Cooling Fan and Shroud Replacement. 13. Install the accessory drive belt tensioner. Refer to Drive Belt Tensioner Replacement Accessory for the 5.3L engine or Drive Belt Tensioner Replacement - Accessory for the 6.0L engine. Page 715 7. Apply pressure and gently rock the cover until one locking leg is unseated. 8. Continue to apply pressure and rock the cover until the second locking leg is unseated. Repeat procedure for the other side of the dress cover and remove the cover. 9. Use J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) to gently lift the terminal retaining tab while gently pulling the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 10. If the terminal is severely bent or damaged, it may be possible on some connectors to push the wire out of the front of the connector instead of Service and Repair Engine Oil Dip Stick - Dip Stick Tube: Service and Repair Oil Level Indicator and Tube Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Remove the cylinder number 2 spark plug and wire. Refer to Spark Plug Replacement 2. Remove the oil level indicator from the tube. 3. Remove the oil level indicator tube bolt. 4. Remove the oil level indicator tube from the engine block. Important: The O-ring seal may be reused if not cut or damaged. 5. Inspect the O-ring seal for cuts or damage. 6. Remove the O-ring seal from the tube, if required. Installation Procedure Page 8131 Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested: - Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. - Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a component or to other harnesses. - If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A TEST LAMP TOOLS REQUIRED J 35616-200 Test Light - Probe Kit NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminate even though voltage is present. The J 35616-200 is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair of leads. To properly operate this tool use the following procedures. When testing for voltage: 1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested. When testing for ground: 1. Attach one lead to battery positive voltage. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where ground should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is ground at the point being tested. Using Connector Test Adapters USING CONNECTOR TEST ADAPTERS NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Using Fused Jumper Wires USING FUSED JUMPER WIRES TOOLS REQUIRED J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged. The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested. AFL/ECP Connectors AFL/EPC CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 4019 10. Raise the engine 2 1/4 inches measuring from the bottom of the oil pan to the front edge of the transmission support crossmember. 11. Remove the engine mount frame bracket from the frame. Page 1431 If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200 DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J 39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected. IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J 39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and maximum (MAX) values measured. 1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of a suspected circuit to the other. 2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J 39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep). IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value in order to record the full change. 5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling the connections or the wiring, test driving, or performing other operations. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions. 6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9. Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist. Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections TESTING FOR INTERMITTENT CONDITIONS AND POOR CONNECTIONS TOOLS REQUIRED - J 35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit - J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit When the condition is not currently present, but is indicated in DTC history, the cause may be intermittent. An intermittent may also be the cause when there is a customer complaint, but the symptom cannot be duplicated. Refer to the Symptom Table of the system that is suspect of causing the condition before trying to locate an intermittent condition. Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the following items: Wiring broken inside the insulation - Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector - Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself, and corrosion in the wire to terminal contact area, etc. - Pierced or damaged insulation can allow moisture to enter the wiring causing corrosion. The conductor can corrode inside the insulation, with little visible evidence. Look for swollen and stiff sections of wire in the suspect circuits. - Wiring which has been pinched, cut, or its insulation rubbed through may cause an intermittent open or short as the bare area touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle. - Wiring that comes in contact with hot or exhaust components - Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required, in order to verify the customer concern. - Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. - Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis and Vehicle Data Recorder operation. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any inline connectors before replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation. Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination, usually in the underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit. Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper adapter. Always use the J 35616 when probing connectors. Other causes of terminal deformation are improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT IN BUSSED ELECTRICAL CENTERS (BEC) Page 5497 11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the solder equipment. 12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. 13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to cover the first piece of tape. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE SLEEVES TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit IMPORTANT: Use only dura seal splice sleeves. Other splice sleeves may not protect the splice from moisture or provide a good electrical connection. Use duraseal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. Use duraseal splice sleeves where there is special requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire using duraseal splice sleeves. Page 7053 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the TPA. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the nose piece. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. Page 7037 - Most Molex connectors will have the Molex logo on the dresscover of the connector. In some cases the connectors may have MX followed by another letter. The third letter indicates where the connector was made. A connector with MXD is a Molex connector made in Detroit. Sumitomo has a unique symbol on their connector and possibly a part number. The symbol is similar to that of a diamond lying on its side, similar to that shown. The logo could appear anywhere but the most common place is at the wire side of the housing. Tyco/AMP has many different and unique connector designs. Some may or may not have identifiable marks on them. Page 5462 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the rear TPA from the connector. 7. IMPORTANT: The front TPA cannot be removed from the connector. Only move it to the release point. Use a small flat-blade tool to move the front TPA to the release position. 8. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 9. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Molex Connectors Page 4522 2. Locate the two indents of the terminal position assurance (TPA) located on the bottom of the connector body. Page 2332 11. Insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) into the 2 triangular cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 12. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE 1. Prior to installation the terminal must be aligned so the (1) coding lugs align with the (2) coding grooves on the connector. 2. Once the terminal is aligned, slide the terminal into the cavity until the retainer has engaged in the cavity of the connector. 3. Slide the TPA in the connector body and seat it using a small flat bladed tool. The TPA is seated when it is flush with the contact housing. 4. Secure the wires to the connector body using a tie wrap and replace the dress cover and grommet. Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) BOSCH CONNECTORS (2.8 JPT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Pull out the slider on the connector position assurance (CPA) until it is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 1418 Page 7707 Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Testing and Inspection Powertrain Relay Diagnosis Diagnostic Instructions * Perform the Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle prior to using this diagnostic procedure. * Strategy Based Diagnosis for an overview of the diagnostic approach. * Diagnostic Procedure Instructions provide an overview of each diagnostic category. Typical Scan Tool Data Circuit/System Description The powertrain relay is a normally open relay. The relay armature is held in the open position by spring tension. Battery positive voltage is supplied directly to the relay coil and the armature contact at all times. The engine control module (ECM) supplies the ground path to the relay coil control circuit via an internal integrated circuit called an output driver module (ODM). The ODM output control is configured to operate as a low side driver for the powertrain relay. The ODM for the powertrain relay also incorporates a fault detection circuit, which is continuously monitored by the ECM. When the ECM commands the powertrain relay ON, ignition 1 voltage is supplied to the ECM, and to several additional circuits. Diagnostic Aids This test procedure requires that the vehicle battery has passed a load test and is completely charged. Refer to Battery Inspection/Test. See: Starting and Charging/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics/Battery Inspection/Test Circuit/System Verification Important: On the scan tool, the powertrain relay is referred to as the EC ignition relay. 1. Ignition ON, engine OFF, command the powertrain relay ON and OFF several times using the scan tool output control function. You should either hear or feel the relay click with each command. 2. Ignition ON, engine OFF, with a test lamp, probe both test points of all the fuses that are powered by the powertrain relay. The test lamp should illuminate on at least one test point of each fuse. ‹› If the vehicle passes the Circuit/System Verification test, then operate the vehicle within the Conditions for Running the DTC. You may also operate the vehicle within the conditions that are captured in the Freeze Frame/Failure Records Data list. Circuit/System Testing 1. Ignition OFF, disconnect the powertrain relay. 2. Ignition ON, verify that a test lamp does not illuminate between the relay coil control circuit and ground. ‹› If the test lamp illuminates, test the relay coil control circuit for a short to voltage. If the circuit tests normal, replace the ECM. 3. Verify that a test lamp does not illuminate between the relay ignition 1 voltage circuit and ground. ‹› If the test lamp illuminates, test the relay ignition 1 voltage circuit for a short to voltage. If the circuit tests normal, replace the ECM. 4. Verify that a test lamp illuminates between the relay coil B+ and ground. ‹› If the test lamp does not illuminate, test the relay coil B+ circuit for a short to ground or an open/high resistance. 5. Verify that a test lamp illuminates between the relay switch B+ and ground. ‹› If the test lamp does not illuminate, test the relay switch B+ circuit for a short to ground or an open/high resistance. If the circuits test normal and the fuse for the ignition 1 voltage circuit is open, test the ignition 1 voltage circuit to the ECM for a short to ground. If the circuit tests Page 8009 - JST connectors have JST in small letters on their connectors, similar to that above. The location of the logo will vary with the connector size and style. - Kostel has an "LK" with a circle around it. These connector are usually used as a transmissions connection and are currently use on some Cadillac vehicles. Page 2311 Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Page 5800 vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide variety of actions, including: - Wiggling the harness - Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting - Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector - Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation - Relocating a harness or wires All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. Another option is, with the component commanded ON and OFF by the scan tool, move related connectors and wiring and observe the component operation. With the engine running, move related connectors and wiring while monitoring engine operation. If harness or connector movement affects the data displayed, component/system operation, or engine operation, inspect and repair the harness/connections as necessary. You may need to load the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these cases you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide good results as well. There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions, along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the circuit to these kinds of conditions. SALT WATER SPRAY Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture. Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5 percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously. HIGH TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070. Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault condition. The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis. This option does not allow for the same control, however. LOW TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect. If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to -18°C (0°F) from one end and +71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized cooling needs. Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or components in an effort to duplicate the concern. DUPLICATING FAILURE CONDITIONS - If none of the previous tests are successful, attempt to duplicate and/or capture the failure conditions. Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, where applicable, contains the conditions that were present when the DTC set. 1. Review and record Freeze Frame/Failure Records data. 2. Clear the DTCs using the scan tool. 3. Turn the key to OFF and wait 15 seconds. 4. Operate the vehicle under the same conditions that were noted in Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, as closely as possible. The vehicle must also be operating within the Conditions for Running the DTC. Refer to Conditions for Running the DTC in the supporting text if a DTC is being diagnosed. 5. Monitor DTC Status for the DTC being tested. The scan tool will indicate Ran, when the enabling conditions have been satisfied long enough for the DTC to run. The scan tool will also indicate whether the DTC passed or failed. - An alternate method is to drive the vehicle with the DMM connected to a suspected circuit. An abnormal reading on the DMM when the concern occurs, may help you locate the concern. Measuring Frequency Page 7357 Depress the locks that are located on both sides of the wiredress cover and pull the lever over and past the locks. View of the connector when released from the component. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the front of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool push down on one of the locking tabs and pull the cover up until the dress cover releases. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. Page 3765 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Kostal Connectors KOSTAL CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 7787 pulling it through. This will prevent damage to the internal seals of the connector. Once the terminal is pushed out of the connector, cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible and pull the wire through the connector. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE The Micro-Pack 100W connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool was developed to crimp Micro-Pack 100W terminals. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 2. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert the terminal into the crimp tool until the core wings are flush with the anvil on the crimp tool. Be sure that the wings are pointed toward the crimp tool former and release the spring locator. The locator will hold the terminal in place. Inspect the alignment of the terminal wings with the crimp tool former. If the terminal wings are wider than the crimp tool former, remove the terminal and bend the terminal wings in slightly. 5. Place stripped wire into terminal. 6. Crimp the new terminal to the wire. If a jam occurs, press the emergency release to open applicator. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire perform the following procedure in order to replace Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. Page 2903 * The hose connections * The areas surrounding the connections Disconnect the CH-48027-2 (2) from the CH-48027-3 (4). 11. Disconnect the CH-48027-3 (4) from the fuel rail service port. 12. Remove the shop towel from around the fuel rail service port, and place in an approved gasoline container. 13. Install the fuel rail service port cap. 14. Install the engine cover, if required. 15. Tighten the fuel fill cap. Without CH-48027 Caution: Refer to Gasoline/Gasoline Vapors Caution. Caution: Remove the fuel tank cap and relieve the fuel system pressure before servicing the fuel system in order to reduce the risk of personal injury. After you relieve the fuel system pressure, a small amount of fuel may be released when servicing the fuel lines, the fuel injection pump, or the connections. In order to reduce the risk of personal injury, cover the fuel system components with a shop towel before disconnection. This will catch any fuel that may leak out. Place the towel in an approved container when the disconnection is complete. 1. Loosen the fuel fill cap in order to relieve the fuel tank vapor pressure. 2. Remove the engine cover, if required. 3. Remove the fuel rail service port cap. 4. Wrap a shop towel around the fuel rail service port and using a small flat bladed tool, depress (open) the fuel rail test port valve. 5. Remove the shop towel from around the fuel rail service port, and place in an approved gasoline container. 6. Install the fuel rail service port cap. 7. Install the engine cover, if required. 8. Tighten the fuel fill cap. Page 174 Door Module: Diagnostic Aids Arrows and Symbols Arrows and Symbols This Service Data uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations. Arrows and Symbols 1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow Basic Knowledge Required GENERAL ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures contained in the service manual. You should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current (amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram, as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. Decimal and Metric Equivalents Decimal and Metric Equivalents Page 3734 IMPORTANT: Ensure that the dress cover and connector body are both in the released position before reassembling. Failure to do so may cause damage to the connector and component. Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (0.64) BOSCH CONNECTORS (0.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While pressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock until the lever is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Pull the rubber boot that covers the wires back to expose the end of the connector dress cover. 4. Place the connector locking lever in the center of the connector. 5. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs that are on the wire end of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover and connector body and pry up. Page 8633 1. Apply sealant to the threads of the oil pressure sensor. Refer to Sealers, Adhesives, and Lubricants for the correct part number. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Using J 41712 or equivalent, install the oil pressure sensor. Tighten the sensor to 35 N.m (26 lb ft). 3. Connect the oil pressure sensor electrical connector (1). 4. Install the intake manifold. Refer to Intake Manifold Replacement. Page 8018 2. Locate the nose piece locking tabs that are positioned on the side of the connector nose piece. The connector nose piece acts as a terminal positive assurance (TPA) and may be referred to as such. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to push in one of the locking tabs while gently pulling on the same side of the nose piece. 4. Repeat the procedure for the other locking tab and remove the nose piece. 5. Remove the wire dress cover. The following is a general procedure for wire dress cover removal. Use this procedure as a guide, some dress cover removal procedures may vary. 6. Use fingers to squeeze the 2 locking legs of the cover. Page 4805 View of a typical Micro 64 connector. Depress the lock and pull the lever over and past the lock. Page 6908 2. Locate the nose piece locking tabs that are positioned on the side of the connector nose piece. The connector nose piece acts as a terminal positive assurance (TPA) and may be referred to as such. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to push in one of the locking tabs while gently pulling on the same side of the nose piece. 4. Repeat the procedure for the other locking tab and remove the nose piece. 5. Remove the wire dress cover. The following is a general procedure for wire dress cover removal. Use this procedure as a guide, some dress cover removal procedures may vary. 6. Use fingers to squeeze the 2 locking legs of the cover. Page 1899 7. The illustration above identifies the entry canal where the terminal release tool will be inserted, and the terminal cavity. - Terminal (1) - Entry Canal (2) 8. Insert the J-38125-553 (15315247) tool into the entry canal and pry up on the terminal retainer. The terminal retainer is a small plastic piece on the top of the terminal. The terminal retainer must be held up while the terminal is pulled out of the connector. Fuel Pressure Gage Installation and Removal Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection Fuel Pressure Gage Installation and Removal Fuel Pressure Gage Installation and Removal Tools Required CH-48027 Digital Pressure Gage Installation Procedure Caution: Refer to Gasoline/Gasoline Vapors Caution. Caution: Remove the fuel tank cap and relieve the fuel system pressure before servicing the fuel system in order to reduce the risk of personal injury. After you relieve the fuel system pressure, a small amount of fuel may be released when servicing the fuel lines, the fuel injection pump, or the connections. In order to reduce the risk of personal injury, cover the fuel system components with a shop towel before disconnection. This will catch any fuel that may leak out. Place the towel in an approved container when the disconnection is complete. 1. Relieve the fuel system pressure. Refer to Fuel Pressure Relief. 2. Connect the CH-48027-1 (1) to the CH-48027-2 (2). 3. Remove the shop towel from around the fuel rail service port, and place in an approved gasoline container. 4. Perform any tests and/or diagnostics as needed. For the proper usage of the CH-48027 , refer to the manufacture's directions. Removal Procedure Page 7519 2. Locate the two indents of the terminal position assurance (TPA) located on the bottom of the connector body. Page 4905 IMPORTANT: Ensure that the dress cover and connector body are both in the released position before reassembling. Failure to do so may cause damage to the connector and component. Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (0.64) BOSCH CONNECTORS (0.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While pressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock until the lever is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Pull the rubber boot that covers the wires back to expose the end of the connector dress cover. 4. Place the connector locking lever in the center of the connector. 5. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs that are on the wire end of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover and connector body and pry up. Page 430 2. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully push the terminal position assurance (TPA) towards the face of the connector on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA is fragile and may break if not done carefully. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. 3. Use the J 38125-215 tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 764 If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the DuraSeal splice sleeves. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: - Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. - Do not use the crimp and DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 to crimp DuraSeal splice sleeve. In order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 2547 Page 7232 11. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 12. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 13. Center the high temperature SCT1 shrink tube over the DuraSeal splice sleeve. 14. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the high temperature heat shrink tubing. 15. Gradually move the heat from the center to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 16. Replace any reflective tape and clips that may have been remove during the repair. Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation REPAIRING DAMAGED WIRE INSULATION Wire Size Conversion Page 4356 Page 3792 breakers are used. CIRCUIT BREAKER This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high current is removed. POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) CIRCUIT BREAKER This type greatly increases its resistance when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker will re-close within a second or 2. Circuit Protection - Fuses CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSES The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and examine the element in the fuse for an open (2). If not broken (1), also check for continuity using a DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one of equal current rating. Circuit Protection - Fusible Links CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSIBLE LINKS Page 6597 6. Gently pry the plastic terminal retainer down and carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (16-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, pull the two connector halves apart. Page 3422 View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. View of the release tool being used for the smaller terminals. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (2-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 7069 3. Remove the dress cover by using a flat-blade tool to release the connector locking tabs and pulling off the dress cover. 4. Relieve the tension on the nose piece retainers by inserting J-38125-12A (12094429) into the single retainer slot on the end of the nose piece and gently prying out the locking tab. Repeat the process for both of the nose piece locking tabs on the opposite side of the nose piece. Locations Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Locations Park Neutral Position (PNP) Switch 1 - Automatic Transmission 4L60-E/4L65-E/4L70 2 - Park/Neutral Position (PNP) Switch Page 1740 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) and slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. Page 6896 Connector Anatomy Connector Repairs contains a list of all connector repairs. The connector repairs are listed by the connector manufacturer and then by connector type. If the technician cannot identify the manufacturer of the connector, refer to Identifying Connectors below. Knowing the connector manufacturer will assist in finding the correct connector repair from the following list: - Connector Position Assurance Locks - Terminal Position Assurance Locks - Bosch Connectors (0.64) Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) Bosch Connectors (BSK) Bosch Connectors (ECM) - Delphi Connectors (Micro.64) Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) Delphi Connectors (12-Way) - Tyco/AMP Connectors (CM 42-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) Tyco/AMP Connectors (025 Cap) Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) - Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) - Repairing Connector Terminals IDENTIFYING CONNECTORS Knowing the connector manufacturer is helpful when trying to locating the correct connector repair procedure. There are many different connector designs used on GM vehicles and it is sometimes difficult to identify the connector manufacturer. The information in this document should help with the identification of connector manufactures. The following connector manufacturers make most of the connectors found in GM vehicles: AFL/EPC (Alcoa Fujikura Ltd./Engineered Plastics Components) - Bosch - Delphi - FCI (Framatome Connectors International) - JAE (Japan Aviation Electronics) - JST (Japan Solderless Terminals) Page 8135 Release the tabs that are holding the wiredress cover to the connector body. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the slots on both ends of the connector body. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. J 38125-216 can also be used to remove the nose piece. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by lifting the terminal retaining tabs on the inside of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 2487 3. Use a small flat-bladed tool to gently pry off the dress cover by inserting the tool under the cover opposite the harness side and prying up. 4. Remove the cover. 5. Using a small flat-bladed tool, push on the side of the nose piece retainer while pushing the nose piece forward with your thumb. This will release the terminal position assurance (TPA). 6. Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) into the corresponding terminal release cavity. The release cavities are the 2 center rows of cavities on one half of the connector. Page 8083 Engine Control Module (ECM) C2 (Pin 55 To 73) Engine Control Module (ECM) C3 Page 6364 2. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 2477 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the rear TPA from the connector. 7. IMPORTANT: The front TPA cannot be removed from the connector. Only move it to the release point. Use a small flat-blade tool to move the front TPA to the release position. 8. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 9. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Molex Connectors Page 4422 8. Insert the J 38125-213 into the small terminal release hole on the nose piece and gently pull on the back of the wire. 9. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Repairing Connector Terminals REPAIRING CONNECTOR TERMINALS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following: Push to Seat terminals - Pull to Seat terminals Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your terminal repair. The J-38125 contains further information. 1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.For cable seal terminals, remove the seal. 2. Apply the correct cable seal per gage size of the wire, if used.Slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation removal. 3. Remove the insulation. 4. For sealed terminals only, align the seal with the end of the cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal.For sealed terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal. 6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.For sealed terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable. 8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals excepting Micro-Pack 100.64 size. Soldering Micro-Pack 100 World terminals may damage the terminal. Sumitomo Connectors SUMITOMO CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 8073 6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias. Reference the appropriate service manual wiring schematic to obtain the correct diode installation position. 7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for the soldering equipment. 8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed. 9. IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode attachment points with tape. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape. Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable SPLICING TWISTED OR SHIELDED CABLE Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable. 1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splice is made. 3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire. Staggering the splices by 65 mm (2.5 in) is recommended. 4. IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical contact with the drain wire. Re-assemble the cable. Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape. - Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1). - Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire. - Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape. Page 6709 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the rear TPA from the connector. 7. IMPORTANT: The front TPA cannot be removed from the connector. Only move it to the release point. Use a small flat-blade tool to move the front TPA to the release position. 8. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 9. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Molex Connectors Page 8984 Page 6551 - Yazaki has a wedge or arrow shape, similar to that shown. Delphi Connectors (Micro .64) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro 64 connectors. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. The lever lock may be located on the top or sides of the wire dress cover. Locations Body Control Module (BCM) Page 8929 TERMINAL REMOVAL Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors. 1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA) device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1). 3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 4. Gently pull the cable and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector. 5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal, refer to Terminal Repair. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3. Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector. REINSTALLING TERMINAL 1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly, refer to Wiring Repairs. 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3. Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) DELPHI CONNECTORS (WEATHER PACK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 5697 2. Locate the nose piece locking tabs that are positioned on the side of the connector nose piece. The connector nose piece acts as a terminal positive assurance (TPA) and may be referred to as such. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to push in one of the locking tabs while gently pulling on the same side of the nose piece. 4. Repeat the procedure for the other locking tab and remove the nose piece. 5. Remove the wire dress cover. The following is a general procedure for wire dress cover removal. Use this procedure as a guide, some dress cover removal procedures may vary. 6. Use fingers to squeeze the 2 locking legs of the cover. Page 8324 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches, and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original. - The wires insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the possibility of fuel contact. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1). 5. Select the proper duraseal splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool. Refer to the Crimp and Seal Splice Table. 6. Place the duraseal splice sleeve in the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115) crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 7. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to hold the duraseal splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 8. Insert the wires into the duraseal splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel in order to prevent the wire from passing through the splice (3). 9. Close the handles of the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115), until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is applied to the splice sleeve. 10. Shrink the insulation around the splice. - Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. - Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Splicing Inline Harness Diodes SPLICING INLINE HARNESS DIODES Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure. 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode. 2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool. 5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode. Page 2852 Toe Description Toe is a measurement of how much the front and/or rear wheels are turned in or out from a straight-ahead position. When the wheels are turned in, toe is positive (+). When the wheels are turned out, toe is negative (-). The actual amount of toe is normally only a fraction of a degree. The purpose of toe is to ensure that the wheels roll parallel. Toe also offsets the small deflections of the wheel support system that occur when the vehicle is rolling forward. In other words, with the vehicle standing still and the wheels set with toe-in, the wheels tend to roll parallel on the road when the vehicle is moving. Improper toe adjustment will cause premature tire wear and cause steering instability. Setback Description Setback Description Setback applies to both the front and the rear wheels. Setback is the amount that one wheel may be aligned behind the other wheel. Setback may be the result of a road hazard or a collision. The first clue is a caster difference from side-to-side of more than 1 degree. Thrust Angles Description Thrust Angles Description Thrust Angles Description The front wheels aim or steer the vehicle. The rear wheels control tracking. This tracking action relates to the thrust angle (3). The thrust angle is the path that the rear wheels take. Ideally, the thrust angle is geometrically aligned with the body centerline (2). In the illustration, toe-in is shown on the left rear wheel, moving the thrust line (1) off center. The resulting deviation from the centerline is the thrust angle. Page 553 11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the solder equipment. 12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. 13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to cover the first piece of tape. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE SLEEVES TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit IMPORTANT: Use only dura seal splice sleeves. Other splice sleeves may not protect the splice from moisture or provide a good electrical connection. Use duraseal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. Use duraseal splice sleeves where there is special requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire using duraseal splice sleeves. Page 794 normal, replace the ECM. 6. Connect a test lamp between the relay coil B+ and the relay coil control circuit. 7. Ignition ON, command the powertrain relay ON and OFF with a scan tool. The test lamp should turn ON and OFF when changing between the commanded states. ‹› If the test lamp is always ON, test the relay coil control circuit for a short to ground. If the circuit tests normal, replace the ECM. ‹› If the test lamp is always OFF, test the relay coil control circuit for a short to voltage or an open/high resistance. If the circuit tests normal, replace the ECM. 8. Connect a 20A fused jumper wire between the relay switch B+ and the relay ignition 1 voltage circuit. 9. Ignition ON, engine OFF, monitor the EC Ignition Relay Feedback parameter with a scan tool. The parameter should display B+. ‹› If the parameter does not display B+, test the ignition 1 voltage circuit for an open/high resistance. If the circuit tests normal, replace the ECM. 10. If all circuits test normal, test or replace the relay. Component Testing 1. Ignition OFF, disconnect the powertrain relay. 2. Test for 65-110 ohms of resistance between terminals 85 and 86 of the relay. ‹› If the resistance is not within the specified range, replace the relay. 3. Test for infinite resistance between following terminals: * Terminal 30 and 86 * Terminal 30 and 87 * Terminal 30 and 85 * Terminal 85 and 87 ‹› If not the specified value, replace the relay. 4. Install a 20A fused jumper wire between relay terminal 85 and 12 volts. Install a jumper wire between relay terminal 86 and ground. Test for less than 1 ohm of resistance between terminals 30 and 87. ‹› If greater than the specified range, replace the relay. Repair Instructions Perform the Diagnostic Repair Verification after completing the diagnostic procedure. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests and Procedures * Relay Replacement (Attached to Wire Harness) Relay Replacement (Within an Electrical Center) * Underhood Electrical Center or Junction Block Replacement * Control Module References for ECM replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Page 8705 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry one side of the nose piece up to the pre-stage position. When the nose piece is in the pre-staged position, the nose piece will be raised above the connector body the length of the step in the nose piece. 7. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry the other side of the piece to the pre-stage position. If the nose piece is higher than the first step in the nose piece, gently push down on the nose piece until it meets with resistance from the connector body, you should feel the nose piece click into position. Page 7683 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Start in the middle and gradually move the heat barrel to the open ends of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Heated Oxygen Sensor Wiring Repairs HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being obstructed. If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. - Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks, etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire. - Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance. - To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector. Page 7469 Information Bus: Diagnostic Aids Arrows and Symbols Arrows and Symbols This Service Data uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations. Arrows and Symbols 1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow Basic Knowledge Required GENERAL ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures contained in the service manual. You should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current (amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram, as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. Decimal and Metric Equivalents Decimal and Metric Equivalents Page 2567 Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested: - Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. - Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a component or to other harnesses. - If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A TEST LAMP TOOLS REQUIRED J 35616-200 Test Light - Probe Kit NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminate even though voltage is present. The J 35616-200 is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair of leads. To properly operate this tool use the following procedures. When testing for voltage: 1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested. When testing for ground: 1. Attach one lead to battery positive voltage. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where ground should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is ground at the point being tested. Using Connector Test Adapters USING CONNECTOR TEST ADAPTERS NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Using Fused Jumper Wires USING FUSED JUMPER WIRES TOOLS REQUIRED J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged. The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested. AFL/ECP Connectors AFL/EPC CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 6922 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully raise the TPA on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA cannot be removed from the connector while there are terminals present in the connector body. View of the TPA when removed from the connector body. 4. Use the J 38125-12A tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the left side of the terminal release cavity as shown in the graphic. Use the tool to move the terminal release to the right with a gentle prying motion. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 1449 - In some cases Delphi will actually be printed on the connector. If Delphi is not printed on the connector, look for PED. In both cases there is no specific orientation for Delphi or PED and they can appear anywhere on the connector. - FCI connectors may have the FCI logo on their connectors. The logo is the letters FCI with an "A" above it. - JAE connector have JAE in small letters on their connectors. Page 1939 Oxygen Sensor: Service Precautions Excessive Force and Oxygen Sensor Notice Excessive Force and Oxygen Sensor Notice Notice: The oxygen sensor may be difficult to remove when the engine temperature is below 48°C (120°F). Excessive force may damage threads in the exhaust manifold or the exhaust pipe. Page 5893 Knock Sensor: Connector Views Engine Controls Connector End Views Knock Sensor (KS) 1 - Left Knock Sensor (KS) 2 - Right Page 2738 Ride Height Sensor: Diagrams Air Suspension Sensor - RR Air Suspension Sensor - RR Air Suspension Sensor - RR Page 1682 7. Connect the MAF/IAT electrical connector. Page 8276 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) and slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. Page 2595 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Ensure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the Terminal Removal Procedure. Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PULL TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL If the terminal is visibly damaged or is suspected of having a faulty connection, the terminal should be replaced. Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors: 1. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) device and/or the secondary lock. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component or separate the connectors for in-line connectors. 3. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device. 4. Insert the proper pick or removal tool into the front of the connector body. 5. IMPORTANT: On connectors with more than one terminal the service loop may not be large enough to remove the terminal and crimp on a new one. If the terminal wire does not have a large enough service loop for removal, cut the wire 5 cm (2 in) behind the connector before removal. Grasp the wire at the back of the connector body and gently push the terminal out the front of the connector body. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. If the wire needed to be cut in order to remove the terminal, gently push a small length of the same size wire through the back of the connector cavity until there is enough wire exposed in order to crimp on a new terminal. If the wire was not cut, cut the existing wire as close to the old terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 4. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. TERMINAL INSTALLATION 1. Align the terminal and pull the wire from the back of the connector in order to seat the terminal. 2. If necessary, cut the new wire to proper length and splice with existing circuit. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. 3. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply dielectric grease to the connector. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PUSH TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 400 REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. The release tab is located on the top of the wiredress cover. View of connector in released position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Page 1436 3. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. View showing depressing of the lever lock release tab. Page 3430 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Start in the middle and gradually move the heat barrel to the open ends of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Heated Oxygen Sensor Wiring Repairs HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being obstructed. If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. - Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks, etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire. - Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance. - To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector. Page 3351 Checking Aftermarket Accessories CHECKING AFTERMARKET ACCESSORIES Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits: - CAUTION: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol. - NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice. OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol. Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the cause of the problems. Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include: Power feeds connected to points other than the battery - Antenna location - Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring - Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line - Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories. Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions INDUCING INTERMITTENT FAULT CONDITIONS TOOLS REQUIRED J 25070 Heat Gun Many intermittent open or shorted circuits are affected by harness/connector movement that is caused by vibration, engine torque, bumps/rough pavement, etc. In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness if the malfunction appears to be Page 365 Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested: - Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. - Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a component or to other harnesses. - If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A TEST LAMP TOOLS REQUIRED J 35616-200 Test Light - Probe Kit NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminate even though voltage is present. The J 35616-200 is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair of leads. To properly operate this tool use the following procedures. When testing for voltage: 1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested. When testing for ground: 1. Attach one lead to battery positive voltage. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where ground should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is ground at the point being tested. Using Connector Test Adapters USING CONNECTOR TEST ADAPTERS NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Using Fused Jumper Wires USING FUSED JUMPER WIRES TOOLS REQUIRED J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged. The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested. AFL/ECP Connectors AFL/EPC CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 1891 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the rear TPA from the connector. 7. IMPORTANT: The front TPA cannot be removed from the connector. Only move it to the release point. Use a small flat-blade tool to move the front TPA to the release position. 8. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 9. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Molex Connectors Page 1472 2. Locate the two indents of the terminal position assurance (TPA) located on the bottom of the connector body. Page 5575 4. Slide the dress cover forward and off of the connector. 5. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front and rear of the connector. Page 6424 Release the tabs that are holding the wiredress cover to the connector body. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the slots on both ends of the connector body. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. J 38125-216 can also be used to remove the nose piece. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by lifting the terminal retaining tabs on the inside of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 2628 Release the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the blue locking tabs on both ends of the connector. Gently slide the TPA up to the released position on both ends. 6. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-13A (GM P/N 12031876-1) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. Page 5422 View of connector in released position. 4. Disconnect the connector from the component. 5. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Release the rear lower half of the wiredress cover. Page 8942 4. Slide the dress cover forward and off of the connector. 5. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front and rear of the connector. Page 2263 3. Use a small flat-bladed tool to gently pry off the dress cover by inserting the tool under the cover opposite the harness side and prying up. 4. Remove the cover. 5. Using a small flat-bladed tool, push on the side of the nose piece retainer while pushing the nose piece forward with your thumb. This will release the terminal position assurance (TPA). 6. Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) into the corresponding terminal release cavity. The release cavities are the 2 center rows of cavities on one half of the connector. Page 9009 IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals. Front probe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the connector. IMPORTANT: When probing female 0.64 terminals, it is important to use the correct adapter. There have been some revisions to the test adapter for 0.64 terminals. The proper adapter for 0.64 terminals is the J 35616-64B which has a gold terminal and a black wire between the base and tip. Failure to use the proper test adapter may result in damage to the terminal being tested and improper diagnosis. NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Page 221 REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. The release tab is located on the top of the wiredress cover. View of connector in released position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Page 4297 Ignition Cable: Testing and Inspection Spark Plug Wire Inspection Spark plug wire integrity is vital for proper engine operation. A thorough inspection is necessary to accurately identify conditions that may affect engine operation. Inspect for the following conditions: 1. Correct routing of the spark plug wires - Incorrect routing may cause cross-firing. 2. Any signs of cracks or splits in the wires. 3. Inspect each boot for the following conditions: * Tearing * Piercing * Arcing * Carbon tracking * Corroded terminal If corrosion, carbon tracking or arcing are indicated on a spark plug wire boot or terminal, replace the wire and the component connected to the wire. Page 459 Page 4967 The engine harness may be repaired using the J-38125. High Temperature Wiring Repairs HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperatures, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time may use materials i.e. wires, connectors, and shielding that has a higher heat rating than typical wiring. When making a repair in a high temperature area observe the following: Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature to replace any damaged wire. - Replace any heat shielding that is removed. - Cover any DuraSeal splice sleeves with SCT1 shrink tubing (available in the J-38125 Terminal Repair kit). - After making a wiring repair, ensure that the location of the wiring is not moved closer to the heat source. IDENTIFYING HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperature, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time need special considerations when making wiring repairs. Areas that may be exposed to higher temperatures can be identified by heat resistant materials that are being used in those areas. These materials may include heat reflective tape, moon tape, and high temperature shrink tubing. Also conduit and other protective coverings may be used. Because conduit or similar coverings are used throughout the vehicle regardless of the temperature, it may be necessary for the technician to determine if an area is exposed to excessive heat before making a wiring repair. Obvious areas of consideration would be any area located near the exhaust manifolds, catalytic converter, and exhaust pipes. The J-38125 contains much of the material you will need to perform repairs on areas exposed to high heat. The kit contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves to crimp and seal connections - High temperature SCT1 shrink tubing to protect the splice sleeves - A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct crimp tool to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools to remove the terminals from the connectors The J-38125 does not contain wire that is suitable to high temperature exposure. Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature of the same or larger gage size as the original wire when repair damage wire. Also replace any reflective tape that you remove during the repair. HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature rating of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125 and then encapsulate the splice sleeve using the high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the order listed. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip keeping all of the wire strands intact. Page 4827 View of typical connector. View of connector in released position. 1. Locate the assist lever at the back of the connector. Move the assist lever to the rear position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the dress cover. Page 7007 All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system. Page 2033 2. Use a small flat-bladed tool to release the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting the tool in the small recess on the side of the connector and pushing up until the TPA releases from the connector body. The TPA should raise just slightly. Do not try to remove the TPA. IMPORTANT: The TPA on this connector cannot be removed unless the terminals are removed first. The TPA will come out of the connector body, but only slightly. When the TPA is slightly raised the terminals can be removed. Using excessive force to remove the TPA with the terminals still in the connector will damage the connector. 3. Repeat the process for the other side of the connector. 4. Ensure that the TPA is in the proper position to remove the terminals. Page 4916 View of the connector when released from the component. View of another type of Micro 64 connector. Page 8540 View of the connector when released from the component. View of another type of Micro 64 connector. Page 1303 Page 7211 9. The illustration shows a cutaway view of the connector to aid the technician in releasing the terminal retainer. 10. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Terminal Position Assurance Locks TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Tyco/Amp Connectors (CM 42-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (CM 42-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the connector body and pull the CPA out. The CPA is on the wire harness side of connector. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 7002 Page 2622 2. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 533 3. Ensure that the terminal release tang access panel is in the correct location to access the terminals. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) into the terminal release tang access slot located behind the access panel of the connector and press down on the terminal while carefully pulling the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Tyco/AMP Connectors (0.25 Cap) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (025 CAP) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component by pressing down on the connector position assurance (CPA). Page 3451 Fuse Block - Rear C2 (Pin A1 To E3) Page 7524 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the rear TPA from the connector. 7. IMPORTANT: The front TPA cannot be removed from the connector. Only move it to the release point. Use a small flat-blade tool to move the front TPA to the release position. 8. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 9. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Molex Connectors Page 2229 View of a typical Micro 64 connector. Depress the lock and pull the lever over and past the lock. Page 3849 Allow at least a two hour soak time between engine OFF and start up when evaluating the tick noise. 2. Start the engine and evaluate the valve lifter tick noise. ‹› If the valve lifter tick noise is still present, replace all 16 valve lifters. Refer to Valve Lifter Replacement in SI. Parts Information Note A V8 AFM engine requires 8 AFM lifters and 8 non-AFM lifters for a total of 16 lifters. Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use: Warranty Information (Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 5779 Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Mass Airflow Sensor/Intake Air Temperature Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure Important: Use care when handling the mass air flow (MAF)/intake air temperature (IAT) sensor. Do not dent, puncture, or otherwise damage the honeycell located at the air inlet end of the MAF/IAT. Do not touch the sensing elements or allow anything including cleaning solvents and lubricants to come in contact with them. Use a small amount of a non-silicone based lubricant, on the air duct only, to aid in installation. 1. Disconnect the MAF/IAT sensor electrical connector. 2. Loosen the clamps at the MAF/IAT sensor and the throttle body. 3. Remove the air cleaner outlet duct bolt. 4. Remove the air cleaner outlet duct. 5. Loosen the clamp attaching the MAF/IAT sensor to the air cleaner housing. 6. Remove the MAF/IAT sensor from the air cleaner housing. Installation Procedure Important: The embossed arrow on the MAF/IAT sensor indicates the proper air flow direction. The arrow must point toward the engine. Page 5187 pulling it through. This will prevent damage to the internal seals of the connector. Once the terminal is pushed out of the connector, cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible and pull the wire through the connector. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE The Micro-Pack 100W connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool was developed to crimp Micro-Pack 100W terminals. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 2. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert the terminal into the crimp tool until the core wings are flush with the anvil on the crimp tool. Be sure that the wings are pointed toward the crimp tool former and release the spring locator. The locator will hold the terminal in place. Inspect the alignment of the terminal wings with the crimp tool former. If the terminal wings are wider than the crimp tool former, remove the terminal and bend the terminal wings in slightly. 5. Place stripped wire into terminal. 6. Crimp the new terminal to the wire. If a jam occurs, press the emergency release to open applicator. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire perform the following procedure in order to replace Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. OnStar(R) - Language Change Information Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Language Change Information Bulletin No.: 05-08-46-009B Date: June 29, 2007 INFORMATION Subject: Language Change for OnStar(R) System (U.S. and Canada Only) Models: 2006-2008 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2006-2008 HUMMER H2, H3 2006-2008 Saab 9-7X with OnStar(R) (RPO UE1) Built After and Including VIN Breakpoints Listed Below (2006 MY Only) Attention: This bulletin only applies to vehicles equipped with OnStar(R) Generation 6.1 or later with a Station Identification (STID) Number in the following range: 16,000,000-17,000,000 or 20,000,000-21,999,999 or 23,500,001-26,000,000 Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the service procedure and add a Canadian procedure. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Numbers 05-08-46-009A and 05-08-46-008A (Section 08 - Body and Accessories). Page 5746 If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs SIR/SRS WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS, and the wiring components, such as connectors and terminals. IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system terminals. Use either an SIR/SRS pigtail or a terminated lead from the SIR Repair Kit Tray. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves, in order to repair the SIR/SRS wiring - A special crimping tool - A heat torch - An instruction manual The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides the necessary low resistance contact integrity for these sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors SIR/SRS CONNECTOR REPAIR (PLASTIC BODY AND TERMINAL METAL PIN) The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made with a special plating. This plating provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. Use the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit for repairing SIR/SRS terminals and connectors. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the repair kit. The J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit contains: Various terminated leads for sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) terminal replacement - Various connector positive assurance (CPA) locks for SIR/SRS connectors - Base of steering column pigtail connectors part number 12085514 - Yellow vinyl electrical tape Pigtail repair packs are available for SIR/SRS connectors with eight or less terminals. Only the connector body is available for connectors with more than eight terminals. The terminated leads in the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit can be used to replace damaged terminals when replacing the connector body. SIR/SRS COMPONENT WIRE PIGTAIL REPAIR IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails. A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device, not by a connector. If a wiring pigtail is damaged, you must replace the entire component, with pigtail. The inflatable restraint steering wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component. SIR/SRS WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 482 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. 4. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front of the connector. Page 528 3. Use a small flat-bladed tool to gently pry off the dress cover by inserting the tool under the cover opposite the harness side and prying up. 4. Remove the cover. 5. Using a small flat-bladed tool, push on the side of the nose piece retainer while pushing the nose piece forward with your thumb. This will release the terminal position assurance (TPA). 6. Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) into the corresponding terminal release cavity. The release cavities are the 2 center rows of cavities on one half of the connector. Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON Air Filter Element: Customer Interest Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-013B Date: February 01, 2007 INFORMATION Subject: Automatic Transmission Shift, Engine Driveability Concerns or Service Engine Soon (SES) Light On as a Result of the Use of an Excessively/Over-Oiled Aftermarket, Reusable Air Filter Models: 2007 and Prior GM Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2007 and Prior Saturn Models 2003-2007 HUMMER H2 2006-2007 HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 04-07-30-013A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle). The use of an excessively/over-oiled aftermarket, reusable air filter may result in: Service Engine Soon (SES) light on Transmission shift concerns, slipping and damaged clutch(es) or band(s) Engine driveability concerns, poor acceleration from a stop, limited engine RPM range The oil that is used on these air filter elements may be transferred onto the Mass Air Flow (MAF) sensor causing contamination of the sensor. As a result, the Grams per Second (GPS) signal from the MAF may be low and any or all of the concerns listed above may occur. When servicing a vehicle with any of these concerns, be sure to check for the presence of an aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter. The MAF, GPS reading should be compared to a like vehicle with an OEM air box and filter under the same driving conditions to verify the concern. The use of an aftermarket reusable air filter DOES NOT void the vehicle's warranty. If an aftermarket reusable air filter is used, technicians should inspect the MAF sensor element and the air induction hose for contamination of oil prior to making warranty repairs. Transmission or engine driveability concerns (related to the MAF sensor being contaminated with oil) that are the result of the use of an aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter are not considered to be warrantable repair items. Page 5803 Refer to the following table as a guide in selecting the correct test adapter for front probing connectors: Backprobe IMPORTANT: Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures. - Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector. - Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large of a test probe. - After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected, test for proper terminal contact. Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the connector. Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure SCAN TOOL SNAPSHOT PROCEDURE Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used Page 8148 - Most Molex connectors will have the Molex logo on the dresscover of the connector. In some cases the connectors may have MX followed by another letter. The third letter indicates where the connector was made. A connector with MXD is a Molex connector made in Detroit. Sumitomo has a unique symbol on their connector and possibly a part number. The symbol is similar to that of a diamond lying on its side, similar to that shown. The logo could appear anywhere but the most common place is at the wire side of the housing. Tyco/AMP has many different and unique connector designs. Some may or may not have identifiable marks on them. Page 2485 7. The illustration above identifies the entry canal where the terminal release tool will be inserted, and the terminal cavity. - Terminal (1) - Entry Canal (2) 8. Insert the J-38125-553 (15315247) tool into the entry canal and pry up on the terminal retainer. The terminal retainer is a small plastic piece on the top of the terminal. The terminal retainer must be held up while the terminal is pulled out of the connector. Page 7595 Page 8038 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. 4. Remove the dress cover by using a flat bladed tool to release the dress cover locking tabs and lift up on the dress cover. 5. Cut the tie wrap that holds the wires to the connector body. Page 2121 The first connector design of the Micro-Pack 100W (1) has a white connector interface that holds the terminals. The second design of the Micro-Pack 100W (2) has a gray interface to hold the terminals. Also, the first design has terminal cavities that are further apart (3 mm centerline) and offset from the other row of terminal cavities in the connector. The second design has terminals cavities that are closer together (2.54 mm centerline) and aligned vertically. One other way to identify the second design is the thin strip of material that runs along the outside of the cavities. IMPORTANT: There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W terminals which are very similar. Ensure that you have the correct terminal before crimping the new terminal to the wire. The first design connector uses the longer terminal (1) that has a raised area in front of the recess in the terminal. The second design connector uses the shorter terminal without the raised area. Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro-Pack 100W connectors. Some Micro-Pack 100W connector disassembly procedures will vary. Use this procedure as a guide. 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. Engine/Transmission - Aftermarket Calibrations Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine/Transmission - Aftermarket Calibrations INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 09-06-04-026C Date: August 13, 2010 Subject: Identifying Non-GM (Aftermarket) Engine and Transmission Calibrations for V8 Gas Engines Using Tech 2(R) or Global Diagnostic System (GDS) Models: 2006-2011 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Excluding Saab 9-7X) 2006-2009 HUMMER H2 2006-2010 HUMMER H3 Equipped with V8 Gas Powered Engines Only Attention: This bulletin applies to V8 gas powered engines ONLY. For Duramax(TM) diesel powered engines, refer to the latest version of Corporate Bulletin Number 08-06-04-006G. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2011 model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 09-06-04-026A (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). General Motors is identifying an increasing number of engine, transmission and catalytic converter part failures that are the result of non-GM (aftermarket) engine and transmission control calibrations being used. When alteration to the GM-released engine or transmission control calibrations occurs, it subjects powertrain and driveline components (engine , transmission, transfer case, driveshaft and rear axle) to stresses that were not tested by General Motors. It is because of these unknown stresses, and the potential to alter reliability, durability and emissions performance, that GM has adopted a policy that prevents any UNAUTHORIZED dealer warranty claim submissions to any remaining warranty coverage, to the powertrain and driveline components whenever the presence of a non-GM (aftermarket) calibration is confirmed - even if the non-GM control module calibration is subsequently removed. Warranty coverage is based on the equipment and calibrations that were released on the vehicle at time of sale, or subsequently updated by GM. That's because GM testing and validation matches the calibration to a host of criteria that is essential to assure reliability, durability and emissions performance over the life of the warranty coverage and beyond. Stresses resulting from calibrations different from those tested and released by GM can damage or weaken components, leading to poor performance and or shortened life. Additionally, non-GM (aftermarket) issued engine control modifications often do not meet the same emissions performance standards as GM issued calibrations. Depending on state statutes, individuals who install engine control module calibrations that put the vehicle outside the parameters of emissions certification standards may be subject to fines and/or penalties. This bulletin outlines a procedure to identify the presence of non-GM (aftermarket) calibrations. GM recommends performing this check whenever a hard part failure is seen on internal engine or transmission components, or before an engine assembly or transmission assembly is being replaced under warranty. It is also recommended that the engine calibration verification procedure be performed whenever diagnostics indicate that catalytic converter replacement is indicated. The PQC has a process to confirm the ECM/PCM calibration is GM issued. The PQC will require a picture of the engine calibration verification screen, as outlined in this bulletin, before authorizing any V8 gas powered engine replacement. If a non-GM calibration is found and verification has taken place through GM, the remaining powertrain and driveline warranty will be blocked and notated in GMVIS and the dealership will be notified. This block prevents any UNAUTHORIZED warranty claim submission. 1. Connect the Tech 2(R) to the vehicle. 2. Go to: Diagnostics and build the vehicle. 3. Select: Powertrain. 4. Select: Engine. 5. *Select: Engine Control Module or PCM. 6. *Select: Module ID Information or I/M Information System if the Module ID Information selection is not available. 7. *If "I/M information System" was selected, it may be necessary to select "Vehicle Information" in order to display the calibration information. ‹› If the CVN information is displayed as "N/A", it will be necessary to contact the TCSC to obtain the CVN information. Page 4598 Release the tabs that are holding the wiredress cover to the connector body. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the slots on both ends of the connector body. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. J 38125-216 can also be used to remove the nose piece. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by lifting the terminal retaining tabs on the inside of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 2220 6. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs located on the opposite side of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover at the connector end and pry up. 7. Remove the dress cover. 8. Cut the tie wrap on the wire bundle. 9. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting a small flat-bladed tool into the small slot in the end of the slider and pushing on the TPA until it comes out of the connector. When the TPA exits the opposite side of the connector, gasp the TPA and pull it completely out of the connector. 10. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 8593 11. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 12. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 13. Center the high temperature SCT1 shrink tube over the DuraSeal splice sleeve. 14. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the high temperature heat shrink tubing. 15. Gradually move the heat from the center to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 16. Replace any reflective tape and clips that may have been remove during the repair. Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation REPAIRING DAMAGED WIRE INSULATION Wire Size Conversion Page 2365 MOLEX CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. 2. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. Page 2134 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. JST Connectors JST CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, remove the connector from the component. Page 4677 Page 3503 * When lifting or jacking a vehicle, be certain that the lift pads do not contact the exhaust system, brake pipes, cables, HVAC lines, wiring harnesses, fuel lines, or underbody. Such contact may result in damage or unsatisfactory vehicle performance. * When using a frame-contact hoist, only place the pads on flat surfaces. Do not place pads within 50 mm (2 in) of any radius. * Before lifting the vehicle, verify that the vehicle loads are secure and equally distributed. * When major components are removed from the vehicle when supported on a hoist, support the vehicle with jack stands at the opposite end from which the components are being removed and secure the vehicle frame to the hoist pads nearest the component to be removed. Vehicle Jacking * Park the vehicle on a clean, hard, level surface before jacking the vehicle. * Any time you lift the vehicle on one end, chock the wheels at the opposite end. * Use jack stands in order to provide support. * When supporting the vehicle using jack stands, place the jack stands under the side rails or the axle. * When lifting under the rear differential, do not allow the jack pad to contact the rear stabilizer bar or mounting hardware. Page 2558 Checking Aftermarket Accessories CHECKING AFTERMARKET ACCESSORIES Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits: - CAUTION: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol. - NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice. OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol. Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the cause of the problems. Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include: Power feeds connected to points other than the battery - Antenna location - Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring - Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line - Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories. Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions INDUCING INTERMITTENT FAULT CONDITIONS TOOLS REQUIRED J 25070 Heat Gun Many intermittent open or shorted circuits are affected by harness/connector movement that is caused by vibration, engine torque, bumps/rough pavement, etc. In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness if the malfunction appears to be Page 2011 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. JST Connectors JST CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, remove the connector from the component. Page 7320 Page 8580 5. While pushing the terminal forward, insert the J 38125-24 in the release cavity above the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (43-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Page 7756 to analyze the data during the time a vehicle condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a trigger point that you have determined. Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2 snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a first-in, first-out basis. If a third snapshot is taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost. Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types: Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice - Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200 frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not lost if the Scan Tool is powered down. The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis. The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected values by plotting 3 parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful, especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC. Testing for a Short to Voltage TESTING FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4. Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt, there is a short to voltage in the circuit. Testing for Continuity TESTING FOR CONTINUITY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6. Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit. 7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity. With a Test Lamp IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits. 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6. If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity. Testing for Electrical Intermittents TESTING FOR ELECTRICAL INTERMITTENTS Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment. - Testing for Short to Ground - Testing for Continuity - Testing for a Short to Voltage Page 7119 Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under the 5 year / 100,000 mile (160,000 km) emission warranty, use: Warranty Information (Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 5167 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. 4. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front of the connector. Page 9007 vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide variety of actions, including: - Wiggling the harness - Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting - Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector - Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation - Relocating a harness or wires All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. Another option is, with the component commanded ON and OFF by the scan tool, move related connectors and wiring and observe the component operation. With the engine running, move related connectors and wiring while monitoring engine operation. If harness or connector movement affects the data displayed, component/system operation, or engine operation, inspect and repair the harness/connections as necessary. You may need to load the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these cases you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide good results as well. There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions, along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the circuit to these kinds of conditions. SALT WATER SPRAY Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture. Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5 percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously. HIGH TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070. Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault condition. The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis. This option does not allow for the same control, however. LOW TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect. If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to -18°C (0°F) from one end and +71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized cooling needs. Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or components in an effort to duplicate the concern. DUPLICATING FAILURE CONDITIONS - If none of the previous tests are successful, attempt to duplicate and/or capture the failure conditions. Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, where applicable, contains the conditions that were present when the DTC set. 1. Review and record Freeze Frame/Failure Records data. 2. Clear the DTCs using the scan tool. 3. Turn the key to OFF and wait 15 seconds. 4. Operate the vehicle under the same conditions that were noted in Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, as closely as possible. The vehicle must also be operating within the Conditions for Running the DTC. Refer to Conditions for Running the DTC in the supporting text if a DTC is being diagnosed. 5. Monitor DTC Status for the DTC being tested. The scan tool will indicate Ran, when the enabling conditions have been satisfied long enough for the DTC to run. The scan tool will also indicate whether the DTC passed or failed. - An alternate method is to drive the vehicle with the DMM connected to a suspected circuit. An abnormal reading on the DMM when the concern occurs, may help you locate the concern. Measuring Frequency Page 913 Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Testing and Inspection Powertrain Relay Diagnosis Diagnostic Instructions * Perform the Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle prior to using this diagnostic procedure. * Strategy Based Diagnosis for an overview of the diagnostic approach. * Diagnostic Procedure Instructions provide an overview of each diagnostic category. Typical Scan Tool Data Circuit/System Description The powertrain relay is a normally open relay. The relay armature is held in the open position by spring tension. Battery positive voltage is supplied directly to the relay coil and the armature contact at all times. The engine control module (ECM) supplies the ground path to the relay coil control circuit via an internal integrated circuit called an output driver module (ODM). The ODM output control is configured to operate as a low side driver for the powertrain relay. The ODM for the powertrain relay also incorporates a fault detection circuit, which is continuously monitored by the ECM. When the ECM commands the powertrain relay ON, ignition 1 voltage is supplied to the ECM, and to several additional circuits. Diagnostic Aids This test procedure requires that the vehicle battery has passed a load test and is completely charged. Refer to Battery Inspection/Test. See: Starting and Charging/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics/Battery Inspection/Test Circuit/System Verification Important: On the scan tool, the powertrain relay is referred to as the EC ignition relay. 1. Ignition ON, engine OFF, command the powertrain relay ON and OFF several times using the scan tool output control function. You should either hear or feel the relay click with each command. 2. Ignition ON, engine OFF, with a test lamp, probe both test points of all the fuses that are powered by the powertrain relay. The test lamp should illuminate on at least one test point of each fuse. ‹› If the vehicle passes the Circuit/System Verification test, then operate the vehicle within the Conditions for Running the DTC. You may also operate the vehicle within the conditions that are captured in the Freeze Frame/Failure Records Data list. Circuit/System Testing 1. Ignition OFF, disconnect the powertrain relay. 2. Ignition ON, verify that a test lamp does not illuminate between the relay coil control circuit and ground. ‹› If the test lamp illuminates, test the relay coil control circuit for a short to voltage. If the circuit tests normal, replace the ECM. 3. Verify that a test lamp does not illuminate between the relay ignition 1 voltage circuit and ground. ‹› If the test lamp illuminates, test the relay ignition 1 voltage circuit for a short to voltage. If the circuit tests normal, replace the ECM. 4. Verify that a test lamp illuminates between the relay coil B+ and ground. ‹› If the test lamp does not illuminate, test the relay coil B+ circuit for a short to ground or an open/high resistance. 5. Verify that a test lamp illuminates between the relay switch B+ and ground. ‹› If the test lamp does not illuminate, test the relay switch B+ circuit for a short to ground or an open/high resistance. If the circuits test normal and the fuse for the ignition 1 voltage circuit is open, test the ignition 1 voltage circuit to the ECM for a short to ground. If the circuit tests Page 3998 Drive Belt: Testing and Inspection Drive Belt Rumbling and Vibration Diagnosis Drive Belt Rumbling and Vibration Diagnosis Diagnostic Aids The accessory drive components can have an affect on engine vibration. Vibration from the engine operating may cause a body component or another part of the vehicle to make rumbling noise. Vibration can be caused by, but not limited to the A/C system over charged, the power steering system restricted or the incorrect fluid, or an extra load on the generator. To help identify an intermittent or an improper condition, vary the loads on the accessory drive components. The drive belt may have a rumbling condition that can not be seen or felt. Sometimes replacing the drive belt may be the only repair for the symptom. If replacing the drive belt, completing the diagnostic table, and the noise is only heard when the drive belts are installed, there might be an accessory drive component with a failure. Varying the load on the different accessory drive components may aid in identifying which component is causing the rumbling noise. Test Description The numbers below refer to the step numbers on the diagnostic table. 2. This test is to verify that the symptom is present during diagnosing. Other vehicle components may cause a similar symptom. 3. This test is to verify that one of the drive belts is causing the rumbling noise or vibration. Rumbling noise may be confused with an internal engine noise due to the similarity in the description. Remove only one drive belt at a time if the vehicle has multiple drive belts. When removing the drive belts the water pump may not be operating and the engine may overheat. Also DTCs may set when the engine is operating with the drive belts removed. 4. Inspecting the drive belts is to ensure that they are not causing the noise. Small cracks across the ribs of the drive belt will not cause the noise. Belt separation is identified by the plys of the belt separating and may be seen at the edge of the belt our felt as a lump in the belt. 5. Small amounts of pilling is normal condition and acceptable. When the pilling is severe the drive belt does not have a smooth surface for proper operation. 9. Inspecting of the fasteners can eliminate the possibility that the wrong bolt, nut, spacer, or washer was installed. 11. This step should only be performed if the water pump is driven by the drive belt. Inspect the water pump shaft for being bent. Also inspect the water pump bearings for smooth operation and excessive play. Compare the water pump with a known good water pump. 12. Accessory drive component brackets that are bent, cracked, or loose may put extra strain on that accessory component causing it to vibrate. Page 1492 3. Ensure that the terminal release tang access panel is in the correct location to access the terminals. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) into the terminal release tang access slot located behind the access panel of the connector and press down on the terminal while carefully pulling the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Tyco/AMP Connectors (0.25 Cap) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (025 CAP) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component by pressing down on the connector position assurance (CPA). Page 2050 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the DuraSeal splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of a connector. CPAs are used in all SIR System connectors and also in some connectors of other systems. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals of a connection. TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE CLIPS IMPORTANT: When making a splice in an area that may be exposed to moisture use a crimp and seal splice sleeve instead of a Splice Clip. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. Page 6330 Depress the locks that are located on both sides of the wiredress cover and pull the lever over and past the locks. View of the connector when released from the component. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the front of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool push down on one of the locking tabs and pull the cover up until the dress cover releases. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. Page 7330 IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals. Front probe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the connector. IMPORTANT: When probing female 0.64 terminals, it is important to use the correct adapter. There have been some revisions to the test adapter for 0.64 terminals. The proper adapter for 0.64 terminals is the J 35616-64B which has a gold terminal and a black wire between the base and tip. Failure to use the proper test adapter may result in damage to the terminal being tested and improper diagnosis. NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Page 3291 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 4840 7. Pressing the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool in the release cavity of the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and crimper in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (DOOR MODULE) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Side view of connector. View of top of connector. 1. Locate the assist lever and lock on the top of the connector. Page 2143 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry one side of the nose piece up to the pre-stage position. When the nose piece is in the pre-staged position, the nose piece will be raised above the connector body the length of the step in the nose piece. 7. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry the other side of the piece to the pre-stage position. If the nose piece is higher than the first step in the nose piece, gently push down on the nose piece until it meets with resistance from the connector body, you should feel the nose piece click into position. Page 1275 Turn Signal Switch: Diagrams Turn Signal/Multifunction Switch C1 Page 1502 Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size. REPAIRING A FUSIBLE LINK IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient overload protection. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. Flat Wire Repairs FLAT WIRE REPAIRS NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced. GMLAN Wiring Repairs GMLAN WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The GM Local Area Network (GMLAN) System requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working on GMLAN connectors and terminals. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items in order to repair the GMLAN wiring: Dura Seal splice sleeves - A wire stripping tool - J 38125-8 Crimping Tool (GM P/N 12085115) - J 38125-5 Ultra Torch Special Tool (GM P/N 12085116) The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. - A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors GMLAN REPAIRS IMPORTANT: When making a repair to any GMLAN network, the original wire length after the repair must be the same length as before the repair. If the network is a twisted pair, the twist must be maintained after the repair is completed. GMLAN has 2 types of networks, low speed and high speed. Low speed GMLAN has a single wire and works at slow speeds. High speed GMLAN has 2 wires in a twisted pair and works at higher speeds. For more information on GMLAN, refer to Data Link Communications Description and Operation. GMLAN CONNECTOR TERMINAL REPAIR IMPORTANT: A service terminal can be used to replace damaged connector terminals for both high speed and low speed GMLAN systems. When making a connector terminal repair on a GMLAN high speed system with twisted pair wires, do not untwist the wires more than necessary to make the repair. The terminals in the GMLAN system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are available in the J-38125. If the individual terminals are damaged on any GMLAN connection, use the appropriate connector repair procedure in order to repair the terminal. GMLAN WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 3242 - A control module from another vehicle is installed. - Revised software/calibration files have been released for this vehicle. - IMPORTANT: DO NOT re-program the control module with the SAME software/calibration files that are already present in the control module. This is not an effective repair for any type of concern. Verify that the control module contains the correct software/calibration. If incorrect programming is found, reprogram the control module with the most current software/calibration. Refer to Control Module References for replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Testing for Short to Ground TESTING FOR SHORT TO GROUND NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 4. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit. With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is a short to ground in the circuit. Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2. Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). - When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. - If the DMM does not display voltage 4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is shorted. Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A DIGITAL MULTIMETER NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the powertrain control module (PCM), should only be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200 Digital Multimeter (DMM). The J 39200 instruction manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminage even though voltage is present. The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity. IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading. Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the measurement. Page 2164 breakers are used. CIRCUIT BREAKER This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high current is removed. POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) CIRCUIT BREAKER This type greatly increases its resistance when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker will re-close within a second or 2. Circuit Protection - Fuses CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSES The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and examine the element in the fuse for an open (2). If not broken (1), also check for continuity using a DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one of equal current rating. Circuit Protection - Fusible Links CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSIBLE LINKS Page 1588 - In some cases Delphi will actually be printed on the connector. If Delphi is not printed on the connector, look for PED. In both cases there is no specific orientation for Delphi or PED and they can appear anywhere on the connector. - FCI connectors may have the FCI logo on their connectors. The logo is the letters FCI with an "A" above it. - JAE connector have JAE in small letters on their connectors. Page 5438 View of a typical Micro 64 connector. Depress the lock and pull the lever over and past the lock. Page 6577 MOLEX CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. 2. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. Page 3464 Fuse Block - Underhood C3 Page 6594 Release the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the blue locking tabs on both ends of the connector. Gently slide the TPA up to the released position on both ends. 6. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-13A (GM P/N 12031876-1) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. Page 5885 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link). - The wire insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. 5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold them between thumb and forefinger. 7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place. - Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction. - Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip. 8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool closes.Ensure that no strands of wire are cut. 10. Crimp the splice on each end (2). Page 7820 5. While pushing the terminal forward, insert the J 38125-24 in the release cavity above the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (43-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Page 2475 View of typical connector. View of connector in released position. 1. Locate the assist lever at the back of the connector. Move the assist lever to the rear position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the dress cover. Page 5248 Engine Control Module (ECM) C2 (Pin 1 To 10) Page 4850 6. Gently pry the plastic terminal retainer down and carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (16-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, pull the two connector halves apart. Page 5852 MOLEX CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. 2. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. Page 1506 Open the harness by removing any tape. 2. Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. 3. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 4. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent american wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 5. Slide a section of high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing down the length of wire to be spliced. Ensure that the shrink tubing will not interfere with the splice procedure. 6. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 7. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. 8. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 9. Insert the wire into the DuraSeal splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 10. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Page 1768 2. Use a small flat-bladed tool to release the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting the tool in the small recess on the side of the connector and pushing up until the TPA releases from the connector body. The TPA should raise just slightly. Do not try to remove the TPA. IMPORTANT: The TPA on this connector cannot be removed unless the terminals are removed first. The TPA will come out of the connector body, but only slightly. When the TPA is slightly raised the terminals can be removed. Using excessive force to remove the TPA with the terminals still in the connector will damage the connector. 3. Repeat the process for the other side of the connector. 4. Ensure that the TPA is in the proper position to remove the terminals. Page 614 8. Disconnect the 32-way tan electrical connector (2) from the BCM. 9. Disconnect the 24-way gray electrical connector (1) from the BCM. 10. With an upward motion, disconnect the body wiring extension (1) from the rear electrical center. 11. Remove the body wiring extension from the vehicle. INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 1. IMPORTANT: Ensure the sliding latch is fully extended before connecting the body wiring extension to the rear electrical center. Using a downward motion, install the body wiring extension (1) to the rear electrical center. 2. Connect the 24-way gray electrical connector (1) to the BCM. 3. Connect the 32-way tan electrical connector (2) to the BCM. 4. Connect the body wiring extension (1) to the BCM. Page 707 - Yazaki has a wedge or arrow shape, similar to that shown. Delphi Connectors (Micro .64) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro 64 connectors. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. The lever lock may be located on the top or sides of the wire dress cover. Page 8689 The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors. 1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position. 4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool J 38125-10A (GM P/N 12014012-1) into the front (mating end) of the connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal through the back of the connector (2). IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector. 6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. 7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily. 10. Perform system check. Delphi Connectors (12 Way) DELPHI CONNECTORS (12-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. Page 757 Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size. REPAIRING A FUSIBLE LINK IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient overload protection. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. Flat Wire Repairs FLAT WIRE REPAIRS NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced. GMLAN Wiring Repairs GMLAN WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The GM Local Area Network (GMLAN) System requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working on GMLAN connectors and terminals. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items in order to repair the GMLAN wiring: Dura Seal splice sleeves - A wire stripping tool - J 38125-8 Crimping Tool (GM P/N 12085115) - J 38125-5 Ultra Torch Special Tool (GM P/N 12085116) The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. - A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors GMLAN REPAIRS IMPORTANT: When making a repair to any GMLAN network, the original wire length after the repair must be the same length as before the repair. If the network is a twisted pair, the twist must be maintained after the repair is completed. GMLAN has 2 types of networks, low speed and high speed. Low speed GMLAN has a single wire and works at slow speeds. High speed GMLAN has 2 wires in a twisted pair and works at higher speeds. For more information on GMLAN, refer to Data Link Communications Description and Operation. GMLAN CONNECTOR TERMINAL REPAIR IMPORTANT: A service terminal can be used to replace damaged connector terminals for both high speed and low speed GMLAN systems. When making a connector terminal repair on a GMLAN high speed system with twisted pair wires, do not untwist the wires more than necessary to make the repair. The terminals in the GMLAN system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are available in the J-38125. If the individual terminals are damaged on any GMLAN connection, use the appropriate connector repair procedure in order to repair the terminal. GMLAN WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Tire Pressure Sensor Grommet Replacement Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Sensor Grommet Replacement Tire Pressure Sensor Grommet Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Raise the vehicle on a suitable support. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 2. Remove the tire/wheel assembly from the vehicle. Refer to Tire and Wheel Removal and Installation. Important: Before the tire is removed from the wheel, note the following items to avoid tire pressure sensor damage upon tire dismounting: ^ Place the sensors cap and valve on a dry clean surface after removal, the cap is aluminum and the valve is nickel plated to prevent corrosion and are not to be substituted with a cap or valve made of any other material. ^ Position the bead breaking fixture 90 degrees from the valve stem when separating the tire bead from the wheel. ^ Position the mounting/dismounting head so the tire iron, or pry bar can be inserted slightly clockwise of the sensor body when prying the tire bead up and over the mounting/dismounting head. ^ Using the tire machine, rotate the tire/wheel assembly clockwise when transferring the tire bead to the outside of the wheel rim. ^ Repeat items for inner bead. Remove the tire from the wheel. Refer to Tire Mounting and Dismounting. Important: If any tire sealant is noted upon tire dismounting, replace the sensor. Refer to Tire Pressure Sensor Replacement. Also remove all residual liquid sealant from the inside of the tire and wheel surfaces. ^ Remove the tire pressure sensor nut. ^ Remove the sensor from the wheel hole. ^ Remove the sensor grommet from the valve stem. Installation Procedure 1. Clean any dirt or debris from the grommet sealing areas. 2. Install the grommet on the sensor valve stem. Page 4769 Page 4981 Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay: Service and Repair Cooling Fan Relay Replacement Tools Required J 43244 Relay Puller Pliers Removal Procedure 1. Remove the underhood electrical center cover. 2. Using the J 43244, remove the cooling fan relay (3). Installation Procedure Notice: Installation of the proper relay is critical. If an enhanced relay - equipped with a diode - is installed into a position requiring a standard relay - equipped without a diode - excessive current will damage any components associated with the relay or its associated circuits. 1. Install the cooling fan relay (3). 2. Install the underhood electrical center cover. Diagrams Electronic Adjustable Pedals (EAP) Switch Page 3114 4. Install the oil pan and a new gasket. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 5. Install the oil pan bolts. Tighten the oil pan to transmission case bolts alternately and evenly to 11 N.m (97 lb in). 6. If previously removed, install the range selector cable bracket and bolts. Tighten the bolts to 25 N.m (18 lb ft). 7. Apply a small amount of sealant GM P/N 12346004 to the threads of the oil pan drain plug, if equipped. 8. Install the oil pan drain plug, if equipped. Tighten the oil pan drain plug to 18 N.m (13 lb ft). 9. Install the catalytic converter. Refer to Catalytic Converter Replacement (4.2L Engine) Catalytic Converter Replacement (5.3L and 6.0L Engines). 10. Lower the vehicle. 11. Fill the transmission to the proper level with DEXRON(R) III transmission fluid. Refer to Transmission Fluid Checking and Fluid Capacity Specifications. 12. Check the COLD fluid level reading for initial fill only. 13. Inspect the oil pan gasket for leaks. Page 6125 9. The illustration shows a cutaway view of the connector to aid the technician in releasing the terminal retainer. 10. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Terminal Position Assurance Locks TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Tyco/Amp Connectors (CM 42-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (CM 42-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the connector body and pull the CPA out. The CPA is on the wire harness side of connector. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 4876 Quarter Window Switch Replacement Power Window Switch: Service and Repair Quarter Window Switch Replacement QUARTER WINDOW SWITCH REPLACEMENT REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Remove the overhead console. 2. Disconnect the electrical connector (1) from the quarter window switch. 3. Release the tabs retaining the quarter window switch to the overhead console. 4. Remove the quarter window switch from the overhead console. INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 1. Install the quarter window switch to the overhead console, ensuring the retaining tabs are fully seated. 2. Connect the electrical connector (1) to the quarter window switch. 3. Install the overhead console. Page 4923 pulling it through. This will prevent damage to the internal seals of the connector. Once the terminal is pushed out of the connector, cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible and pull the wire through the connector. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE The Micro-Pack 100W connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool was developed to crimp Micro-Pack 100W terminals. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 2. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert the terminal into the crimp tool until the core wings are flush with the anvil on the crimp tool. Be sure that the wings are pointed toward the crimp tool former and release the spring locator. The locator will hold the terminal in place. Inspect the alignment of the terminal wings with the crimp tool former. If the terminal wings are wider than the crimp tool former, remove the terminal and bend the terminal wings in slightly. 5. Place stripped wire into terminal. 6. Crimp the new terminal to the wire. If a jam occurs, press the emergency release to open applicator. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire perform the following procedure in order to replace Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. Page 8172 View of typical connector. View of connector in released position. 1. Locate the assist lever at the back of the connector. Move the assist lever to the rear position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the dress cover. Page 6593 5. While pushing the terminal forward, insert the J 38125-24 in the release cavity above the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (43-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Page 4816 The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors. 1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position. 4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool J 38125-10A (GM P/N 12014012-1) into the front (mating end) of the connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal through the back of the connector (2). IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector. 6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. 7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily. 10. Perform system check. Delphi Connectors (12 Way) DELPHI CONNECTORS (12-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. Page 7367 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) and slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. Page 8378 IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals. Front probe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the connector. IMPORTANT: When probing female 0.64 terminals, it is important to use the correct adapter. There have been some revisions to the test adapter for 0.64 terminals. The proper adapter for 0.64 terminals is the J 35616-64B which has a gold terminal and a black wire between the base and tip. Failure to use the proper test adapter may result in damage to the terminal being tested and improper diagnosis. NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Page 2368 8. Insert the J 38125-213 into the small terminal release hole on the nose piece and gently pull on the back of the wire. 9. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Repairing Connector Terminals REPAIRING CONNECTOR TERMINALS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following: Push to Seat terminals - Pull to Seat terminals Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your terminal repair. The J-38125 contains further information. 1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.For cable seal terminals, remove the seal. 2. Apply the correct cable seal per gage size of the wire, if used.Slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation removal. 3. Remove the insulation. 4. For sealed terminals only, align the seal with the end of the cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal.For sealed terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal. 6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.For sealed terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable. 8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals excepting Micro-Pack 100.64 size. Soldering Micro-Pack 100 World terminals may damage the terminal. Sumitomo Connectors SUMITOMO CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Tires/Wheels - Tire Slowly Goes Flat/Warning Light ON Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Tires/Wheels - Tire Slowly Goes Flat/Warning Light ON TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 08-03-10-006C Date: April 27, 2010 Subject: Tire Slowly Goes Flat, Tire Air Loss, Low Tire Pressure Warning Light Illuminated, Aluminum Wheel Bead Seat Corrosion (Clean and Resurface Wheel Bead Seat) Models: 2000-2011 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2003-2009 HUMMER H2 2006-2010 HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 08-03-10-006B (Section 03 - Suspension). Condition Some customers may comment on a tire that slowly loses air pressure over a period of days or weeks. Cause Abrasive elements in the environment may intrude between the tire and wheel at the bead seat. There is always some relative motion between the tire and wheel (when the vehicle is driven) and this motion may cause the abrasive particles to wear the wheel and tire materials. As the wear continues, there may also be intrusion at the tire/wheel interface by corrosive media from the environment. Eventually a path for air develops and a 'slow' leak may ensue. This corrosion may appear on the inboard or outboard bead seating surface of the wheel. This corrosion will not be visible until the tire is dismounted from the wheel. Notice This bulletin specifically addresses issues related to wheel bead seat corrosion that may result in an air leak. For issues related to porosity of the wheel casting that may result in an air leak, please refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 05-03-10-006F - Low Tire Pressure, Leaking Cast Aluminum Wheels (Repair with Adhesive Sealant) Correction In most cases, this type of air loss can be corrected by following the procedure below. Important DO NOT replace a wheel for slow air loss unless you have evaluated and/or tried to repair the wheel with the procedure below. Notice The repair is no longer advised or applicable for chromed aluminum wheels. 1. Remove the wheel and tire assembly for diagnosis. Refer to Tire and Wheel Removal and Installation in SI. 2. After a water dunk tank leak test, if you determine the source of the air leak to be around the bead seat of the wheel, dismount the tire to examine the bead seat. Shown below is a typical area of bead seat corrosion.Typical Location of Bead Seat Corrosion Page 9076 Release the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the blue locking tabs on both ends of the connector. Gently slide the TPA up to the released position on both ends. 6. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-13A (GM P/N 12031876-1) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. Page 4852 View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. 4. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers CIRCUIT PROTECTION - CIRCUIT BREAKERS A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types of circuit Page 8693 Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. FCI Connectors FCI CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 6146 11. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 12. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 13. Center the high temperature SCT1 shrink tube over the DuraSeal splice sleeve. 14. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the high temperature heat shrink tubing. 15. Gradually move the heat from the center to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 16. Replace any reflective tape and clips that may have been remove during the repair. Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation REPAIRING DAMAGED WIRE INSULATION Wire Size Conversion Page 8291 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry one side of the nose piece up to the pre-stage position. When the nose piece is in the pre-staged position, the nose piece will be raised above the connector body the length of the step in the nose piece. 7. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry the other side of the piece to the pre-stage position. If the nose piece is higher than the first step in the nose piece, gently push down on the nose piece until it meets with resistance from the connector body, you should feel the nose piece click into position. Page 3737 5. Insert the J 38125-557 (GM P/N 12122378) into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 6. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Connector Position Assurance Locks CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of the connector. CPAs are used in various connectors throughout the vehicle. CPAs are also used in all SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals, of the connector. Connector Repairs CONNECTOR REPAIRS Page 5672 Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested: - Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. - Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a component or to other harnesses. - If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A TEST LAMP TOOLS REQUIRED J 35616-200 Test Light - Probe Kit NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminate even though voltage is present. The J 35616-200 is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair of leads. To properly operate this tool use the following procedures. When testing for voltage: 1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested. When testing for ground: 1. Attach one lead to battery positive voltage. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where ground should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is ground at the point being tested. Using Connector Test Adapters USING CONNECTOR TEST ADAPTERS NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Using Fused Jumper Wires USING FUSED JUMPER WIRES TOOLS REQUIRED J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged. The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested. AFL/ECP Connectors AFL/EPC CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 7001 Page 7570 Body Control System Diagram 2 Locations: The locations for the Connectors, Grounds, Splices, and Grommets shown within these diagrams can be found via their numbers at Vehicle Locations. See: Locations Data Communication Diagrams Page 2256 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry one side of the nose piece up to the pre-stage position. When the nose piece is in the pre-staged position, the nose piece will be raised above the connector body the length of the step in the nose piece. 7. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry the other side of the piece to the pre-stage position. If the nose piece is higher than the first step in the nose piece, gently push down on the nose piece until it meets with resistance from the connector body, you should feel the nose piece click into position. Page 7839 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches, and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original. - The wires insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the possibility of fuel contact. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1). 5. Select the proper duraseal splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool. Refer to the Crimp and Seal Splice Table. 6. Place the duraseal splice sleeve in the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115) crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 7. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to hold the duraseal splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 8. Insert the wires into the duraseal splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel in order to prevent the wire from passing through the splice (3). 9. Close the handles of the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115), until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is applied to the splice sleeve. 10. Shrink the insulation around the splice. - Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. - Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Splicing Inline Harness Diodes SPLICING INLINE HARNESS DIODES Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure. 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode. 2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool. 5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode. Page 6196 Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested: - Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. - Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a component or to other harnesses. - If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A TEST LAMP TOOLS REQUIRED J 35616-200 Test Light - Probe Kit NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminate even though voltage is present. The J 35616-200 is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair of leads. To properly operate this tool use the following procedures. When testing for voltage: 1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested. When testing for ground: 1. Attach one lead to battery positive voltage. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where ground should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is ground at the point being tested. Using Connector Test Adapters USING CONNECTOR TEST ADAPTERS NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Using Fused Jumper Wires USING FUSED JUMPER WIRES TOOLS REQUIRED J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged. The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested. AFL/ECP Connectors AFL/EPC CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 7298 results from the alteration or modification of a vehicle using non-GM approved parts or accessories. Dealers should be especially cautious of accessory companies that claim the installation of their product will not void the factory warranty. Many times these companies have even given direction on how to quickly disassemble the accessory in an attempt to preclude the manufacturer from finding out that is has been installed. Any suspect repairs should be reviewed by the Fixed Operations Manager (FOM), and in Canada by the Warranty Manager (WM) for appropriate repair direction. If it is decided that a goodwill repair is to be made on the vehicle, even with the installation of such non-GM approved components, the customer is to be made aware of General Motors position on this issue and is to sign the appropriate goodwill documentation required by General Motors. It is imperative for dealers to understand that by installing such devices, they are jeopardizing not only the warranty coverage, but also the performance and reliability of the customer's vehicle. Disclaimer Page 264 11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the solder equipment. 12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. 13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to cover the first piece of tape. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE SLEEVES TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit IMPORTANT: Use only dura seal splice sleeves. Other splice sleeves may not protect the splice from moisture or provide a good electrical connection. Use duraseal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. Use duraseal splice sleeves where there is special requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire using duraseal splice sleeves. Page 8575 2. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 4304 * Inspect for evidence of improper arcing. - Measure the gap between the center electrode (4) and the side electrode (3). - Inspect for the correct spark plug torque. - Inspect for signs of tracking that occurred near the insulator tip instead of the center electrode (4). - Inspect for a broken or worn side electrode (3). - Inspect for a broken, worn, or loose center electrode (4) by shaking the spark plug. * A rattling sound indicates internal damage. * A looses center electrode (4) reduces the spark intensity. - Inspect for bridged electrodes (3,4). Deposits on the electrodes (3,4) reduce or eliminates the gap. - Inspect for worn or missing platinum pads on the electrodes (3,4), if equipped. - Inspect for excessive fouling. * Inspect the spark plug recess area of the cylinder head for debris. Dirty or damaged threads can cause the spark plug not to seat correctly during installation. Visual Inspection * Normal operation - Brown to grayish-tan with small amounts of white powdery deposits are normal combustion by-products from fuels with additives. * Carbon fouled - Dry, fluffy black carbon, or soot caused by the following conditions: - Rich fuel mixtures * Leaking fuel injectors * Excessive fuel pressure * Restricted air filter element * Incorrect combustion - Reduced ignition system voltage output * Weak ignition coils * Worn ignition wires * Incorrect spark plug gap - Excessive idling or slow speeds under light loads can keep spark plug temperatures so low that normal combustion deposits may not burn off. * Deposit fouling - Oil, coolant, or additives that include substances such as silicone, very white coating, reduces the spark plug intensity. Most powdery deposits will not affect spark plug intensity unless they form into a glazing over the electrode. Page 779 Engine Control Module (ECM) C2 (Pin 55 To 73) Engine Control Module (ECM) C3 Page 5791 Page 6604 The engine harness may be repaired using the J-38125. High Temperature Wiring Repairs HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperatures, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time may use materials i.e. wires, connectors, and shielding that has a higher heat rating than typical wiring. When making a repair in a high temperature area observe the following: Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature to replace any damaged wire. - Replace any heat shielding that is removed. - Cover any DuraSeal splice sleeves with SCT1 shrink tubing (available in the J-38125 Terminal Repair kit). - After making a wiring repair, ensure that the location of the wiring is not moved closer to the heat source. IDENTIFYING HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperature, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time need special considerations when making wiring repairs. Areas that may be exposed to higher temperatures can be identified by heat resistant materials that are being used in those areas. These materials may include heat reflective tape, moon tape, and high temperature shrink tubing. Also conduit and other protective coverings may be used. Because conduit or similar coverings are used throughout the vehicle regardless of the temperature, it may be necessary for the technician to determine if an area is exposed to excessive heat before making a wiring repair. Obvious areas of consideration would be any area located near the exhaust manifolds, catalytic converter, and exhaust pipes. The J-38125 contains much of the material you will need to perform repairs on areas exposed to high heat. The kit contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves to crimp and seal connections - High temperature SCT1 shrink tubing to protect the splice sleeves - A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct crimp tool to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools to remove the terminals from the connectors The J-38125 does not contain wire that is suitable to high temperature exposure. Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature of the same or larger gage size as the original wire when repair damage wire. Also replace any reflective tape that you remove during the repair. HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature rating of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125 and then encapsulate the splice sleeve using the high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the order listed. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip keeping all of the wire strands intact. Page 7218 2. Use a small flat-bladed tool to release the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting the tool in the small recess on the side of the connector and pushing up until the TPA releases from the connector body. The TPA should raise just slightly. Do not try to remove the TPA. IMPORTANT: The TPA on this connector cannot be removed unless the terminals are removed first. The TPA will come out of the connector body, but only slightly. When the TPA is slightly raised the terminals can be removed. Using excessive force to remove the TPA with the terminals still in the connector will damage the connector. 3. Repeat the process for the other side of the connector. 4. Ensure that the TPA is in the proper position to remove the terminals. Page 4539 2. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 3391 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) and slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. Page 8446 View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. View of the release tool being used for the smaller terminals. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (2-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 3364 Release the tabs that are holding the wiredress cover to the connector body. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the slots on both ends of the connector body. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. J 38125-216 can also be used to remove the nose piece. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by lifting the terminal retaining tabs on the inside of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 7528 8. Insert the J 38125-213 into the small terminal release hole on the nose piece and gently pull on the back of the wire. 9. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Repairing Connector Terminals REPAIRING CONNECTOR TERMINALS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following: Push to Seat terminals - Pull to Seat terminals Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your terminal repair. The J-38125 contains further information. 1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.For cable seal terminals, remove the seal. 2. Apply the correct cable seal per gage size of the wire, if used.Slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation removal. 3. Remove the insulation. 4. For sealed terminals only, align the seal with the end of the cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal.For sealed terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal. 6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.For sealed terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable. 8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals excepting Micro-Pack 100.64 size. Soldering Micro-Pack 100 World terminals may damage the terminal. Sumitomo Connectors SUMITOMO CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 3095 Processes shown in the Table 3 are capable of recycling waste engine coolants (DEX-COOL(R) or conventional) to a conventional (green) coolant. Recycling conventional coolant can be accomplished at your facility by a technician using approved EQUIPMENT (listed by model number in Table 3), or by an approved coolant recycling SERVICE which may recycle the coolant at your facility or at an offsite operation. Refer to the table for GM approved coolant recyclers in either of these two categories. Should you decide to recycle the coolant yourself, strict adherence to the operating procedures is imperative. Use ONLY the inhibitor chemicals supplied by the respective (GM approved) recycling equipment manufacturer. Sealing Tablets Cooling System Sealing Tablets (Seal Tabs) should not be used as a regular maintenance item after servicing an engine cooling system. Discoloration of coolant can occur if too many seal tabs have been inserted into the cooling system. This can occur if seal tabs are repeatedly used over the service life of a vehicle. Where appropriate, seal tabs may be used if diagnostics fail to repair a small leak in the cooling system. When a condition appears in which seal tabs may be recommended, a specific bulletin will be released describing their proper usage. Water Quality The integrity of the coolant is dependent upon the quality of DEX-COOL(R) and water. DEX-COOL(R) is a product that has enhanced protection capability as well as an extended service interval. These enhanced properties may be jeopardized by combining DEX-COOL(R) with poor quality water. If you suspect the water in your area of being poor quality, it is recommended you use distilled or de-ionized water with DEX-COOL(R). "Pink" DEX-COOL(R) DEX-COOL(R) is orange in color to distinguish it from other coolants. Due to inconsistencies in the mixing of the dyes used with DEX-COOL(R), some batches may appear pink after time. The color shift from orange to pink does not affect the integrity of the coolant, and still maintains the 5 yr/150,000 mile (240,000 km) service interval. Back Service Only use DEX-COOL(R) if the vehicle was originally equipped with DEX-COOL(R). Diagrams Solar Sensor: Diagrams HVAC Connector End Views Ambient Light/Sunload Sensor Assembly Page 7187 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Ensure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the Terminal Removal Procedure. Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PULL TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL If the terminal is visibly damaged or is suspected of having a faulty connection, the terminal should be replaced. Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors: 1. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) device and/or the secondary lock. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component or separate the connectors for in-line connectors. 3. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device. 4. Insert the proper pick or removal tool into the front of the connector body. 5. IMPORTANT: On connectors with more than one terminal the service loop may not be large enough to remove the terminal and crimp on a new one. If the terminal wire does not have a large enough service loop for removal, cut the wire 5 cm (2 in) behind the connector before removal. Grasp the wire at the back of the connector body and gently push the terminal out the front of the connector body. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. If the wire needed to be cut in order to remove the terminal, gently push a small length of the same size wire through the back of the connector cavity until there is enough wire exposed in order to crimp on a new terminal. If the wire was not cut, cut the existing wire as close to the old terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 4. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. TERMINAL INSTALLATION 1. Align the terminal and pull the wire from the back of the connector in order to seat the terminal. 2. If necessary, cut the new wire to proper length and splice with existing circuit. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. 3. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply dielectric grease to the connector. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PUSH TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 5054 Heat Shield: Service and Repair Exhaust Manifold Heat Shield Replacement - Left Side Exhaust Manifold Heat Shield Replacement - Left Side Removal Procedure 1. Remove the spark plugs. Refer to Spark Plug Replacement for the 5.3L engine or Spark Plug Replacement for the 6.0L engine. 2. Remove the heat shield bolts and the shield from the exhaust manifold. Installation Procedure Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 1. Install the heat shield and the bolts to the exhaust manifold. Tighten the bolts to 9 N.m (80 lb in). 2. Install the spark plugs. Refer to Spark Plug Replacement for the 5.3L engine or Spark Plug Replacement for the 6.0L engine. Page 5502 Page 3736 11. Insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) into the 2 triangular cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 12. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE 1. Prior to installation the terminal must be aligned so the (1) coding lugs align with the (2) coding grooves on the connector. 2. Once the terminal is aligned, slide the terminal into the cavity until the retainer has engaged in the cavity of the connector. 3. Slide the TPA in the connector body and seat it using a small flat bladed tool. The TPA is seated when it is flush with the contact housing. 4. Secure the wires to the connector body using a tie wrap and replace the dress cover and grommet. Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) BOSCH CONNECTORS (2.8 JPT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Pull out the slider on the connector position assurance (CPA) until it is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 4277 Disclaimer Page 1567 IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals. Front probe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the connector. IMPORTANT: When probing female 0.64 terminals, it is important to use the correct adapter. There have been some revisions to the test adapter for 0.64 terminals. The proper adapter for 0.64 terminals is the J 35616-64B which has a gold terminal and a black wire between the base and tip. Failure to use the proper test adapter may result in damage to the terminal being tested and improper diagnosis. NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Electrical - Instrument Panel & General Wiring Repair Wiring Harness: All Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - Instrument Panel & General Wiring Repair Bulletin No.: 06-08-45-004 Date: May 02, 2006 INFORMATION Subject: Instrument Panel (I/P), Body and General Wiring Harness Repair Models: 2007 and Prior GM Cars and Trucks 2003-2007 HUMMER H2 2006-2007 HUMMER H3 Important: A part restriction has been implemented on all Body and I/P harnesses and is being administered by the PQC. If a body or I/P harness replacement is required, it can take 12-28 weeks for a harness to be built and delivered to a dealer. The dealer technician is expected to repair any harness damage as the first and best choice before replacing a harness. In an effort to standardize repair practices, General Motors is requiring that all wiring harnesses be repaired instead of replaced. If there is a question concerning which connector and/or terminal you are working on, refer to the information in the appropriate Connector End Views in SI. The Instruction Manual J 38125-620, which is sent with each new update of the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit, also has terminal crimping and terminal remove information. Important: There are some parts in the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit (i.e. SIR connector CPAs and heat shrink tube (used in high heat area pigtail replacement) and some TPAs that are not available from GMSPO. It is vitally important that each update to the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit be done as soon as it arrives at the dealer. Utilize the Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125) to achieve an effective wiring repair. The Terminal Repair Kit has been an essential tool for all GM Dealers since 1987. Replacement terminals and tools for this kit are available through SPX/Kent Moore. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 06-08-45-001 for more information. The Instruction Manual J 38125-620, which is sent with each new update to the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit, also has terminal crimping and terminal removal information. U.S. Dealers Only - Training courses (including Tech Assists, Emerging Issues, Web, IDL and Hands-on) are available through the GM Training website. Refer to Resources and then Training Materials for a complete list of available courses. Canadian Dealers Only - Refer to the Training section of GM infoNet for a complete list of available courses and a copy of the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit Instruction Manual. Wiring repair information is also available in Service Information (SI). The Wiring Repair section contains information for the following types of wiring repairs: - Testing for intermittent conditions and poor conditions - Flat wire repairs - GMLAN wiring repairs - High temperature wiring repairs - Splicing copper wire using splice clips - Splicing copper wire using splice sleeves - Splicing twisted or shielded cable - Splicing inline harness diodes Page 3447 Fuse Block - Rear C1 (Pin A1 To A10) Page 2078 Page 4498 - Kostel - Molex - Sumitomo - Tyco/AMP - Yazaki Identifying the manufacturer of a connector is often difficult. When trying to determine the manufacturer of a connector, look for specific identifying marks that are unique to that connector supplier. Most of these identify marks are hard to find or see. Check the connector carefully and refer to the information below for pictures and descriptions of connector identification markings. - Most of AFLs connectors have EPC on their connector body. Some of the smaller connectors will not have any markings on them. - In some cases Bosch will actually be printed on the connector. If Bosch does not appear on the connector, look for the Bosch logo. The Bosch logo is a circle with a blunted arrow inside. This logo can appear anywhere on the connector and is often very small. Page 6696 The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors. 1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position. 4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool J 38125-10A (GM P/N 12014012-1) into the front (mating end) of the connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal through the back of the connector (2). IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector. 6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. 7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily. 10. Perform system check. Delphi Connectors (12 Way) DELPHI CONNECTORS (12-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. Page 8396 5. Insert the J 38125-557 (GM P/N 12122378) into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 6. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Connector Position Assurance Locks CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of the connector. CPAs are used in various connectors throughout the vehicle. CPAs are also used in all SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals, of the connector. Connector Repairs CONNECTOR REPAIRS Page 8384 Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested: - Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. - Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a component or to other harnesses. - If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A TEST LAMP TOOLS REQUIRED J 35616-200 Test Light - Probe Kit NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminate even though voltage is present. The J 35616-200 is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair of leads. To properly operate this tool use the following procedures. When testing for voltage: 1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested. When testing for ground: 1. Attach one lead to battery positive voltage. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where ground should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is ground at the point being tested. Using Connector Test Adapters USING CONNECTOR TEST ADAPTERS NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Using Fused Jumper Wires USING FUSED JUMPER WIRES TOOLS REQUIRED J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged. The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested. AFL/ECP Connectors AFL/EPC CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 7600 All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system. Page 7658 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. 4. Remove the dress cover by using a flat bladed tool to release the dress cover locking tabs and lift up on the dress cover. 5. Cut the tie wrap that holds the wires to the connector body. Page 8302 6. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by pressing on the tang. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (SENSOR) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) tool into the cavity on the lower right hand face of the connector until the terminal release tang access panel slides over. Page 5695 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert terminal into the appropriate terminal holder until it hits bottom and stops. The correct terminal holder is determined by the wire size. Also ensure that the terminals wings are pointing towards the former on the tool and the release locator. 5. Insert the stripped cable into the terminal. Insulation should be visible on both sides of the terminal insulation wings. 6. Compress the handles until the ratchet automatically releases. 7. Place the terminal into the appropriate cavity and assemble the connector. Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO-PACK 100W) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W connectors. These connectors are very similar but use different terminals and have some minor physical differences also. Page 1407 1. Locate the air flow direction arrow (2) on the MAF/IAT sensor. 2. Install the MAF/IAT sensor on to the air cleaner housing. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 3. Tighten the clamp securing the MAF/IAT sensor to the air cleaner housing. Tighten the clamp to 7 N.m (62 lb in). 4. Install the air cleaner outlet duct. 5. Install the air cleaner outlet duct bolt. Tighten the bolt to 10 N.m (89 lb in). 6. Tighten the clamps at the MAF/IAT sensor and the throttle body. Tighten the clamps to 7 N.m (62 lb in). Page 5962 - In some cases Delphi will actually be printed on the connector. If Delphi is not printed on the connector, look for PED. In both cases there is no specific orientation for Delphi or PED and they can appear anywhere on the connector. - FCI connectors may have the FCI logo on their connectors. The logo is the letters FCI with an "A" above it. - JAE connector have JAE in small letters on their connectors. Page 8242 If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200 DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J 39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected. IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J 39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and maximum (MAX) values measured. 1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of a suspected circuit to the other. 2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J 39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep). IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value in order to record the full change. 5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling the connections or the wiring, test driving, or performing other operations. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions. 6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9. Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist. Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections TESTING FOR INTERMITTENT CONDITIONS AND POOR CONNECTIONS TOOLS REQUIRED - J 35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit - J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit When the condition is not currently present, but is indicated in DTC history, the cause may be intermittent. An intermittent may also be the cause when there is a customer complaint, but the symptom cannot be duplicated. Refer to the Symptom Table of the system that is suspect of causing the condition before trying to locate an intermittent condition. Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the following items: Wiring broken inside the insulation - Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector - Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself, and corrosion in the wire to terminal contact area, etc. - Pierced or damaged insulation can allow moisture to enter the wiring causing corrosion. The conductor can corrode inside the insulation, with little visible evidence. Look for swollen and stiff sections of wire in the suspect circuits. - Wiring which has been pinched, cut, or its insulation rubbed through may cause an intermittent open or short as the bare area touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle. - Wiring that comes in contact with hot or exhaust components - Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required, in order to verify the customer concern. - Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. - Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis and Vehicle Data Recorder operation. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any inline connectors before replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation. Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination, usually in the underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit. Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper adapter. Always use the J 35616 when probing connectors. Other causes of terminal deformation are improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT IN BUSSED ELECTRICAL CENTERS (BEC) Page 8264 View of a typical Micro 64 connector. Depress the lock and pull the lever over and past the lock. Page 138 3. Position the upper bracket to the processor bracket. 4. Slide the upper bracket outboard until all the retaining tabs are seated to the processor bracket. 5. Install the communication interface module. 6. Install the right rear seat cushion. Page 1569 to analyze the data during the time a vehicle condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a trigger point that you have determined. Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2 snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a first-in, first-out basis. If a third snapshot is taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost. Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types: Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice - Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200 frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not lost if the Scan Tool is powered down. The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis. The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected values by plotting 3 parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful, especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC. Testing for a Short to Voltage TESTING FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4. Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt, there is a short to voltage in the circuit. Testing for Continuity TESTING FOR CONTINUITY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6. Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit. 7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity. With a Test Lamp IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits. 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6. If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity. Testing for Electrical Intermittents TESTING FOR ELECTRICAL INTERMITTENTS Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment. - Testing for Short to Ground - Testing for Continuity - Testing for a Short to Voltage Page 6868 Page 8841 4. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the rear of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. 5. Once the locking tabs are unlocked, slide the inner connector out of the rear of the connector housing. Page 26 In summary, whenever a vehicle subject to this program enters your vehicle inventory, or is in your dealership/facility for service through April 30, 2011, you must take the steps necessary to be sure the program correction has been made before selling or releasing the vehicle. Disclaimer Service Procedure Service Procedure Note Do NOT replace the inside rear view mirror in tandem with this concern. The mirror has no bearing on this specific issue. 1. Remove the OnStar(R) module (referred to as the Communication Interface Module (CIM) or Vehicle Communication Interface Module (VCIM) in SI). Refer to SI for module removal instructions. Note Inform customer that all Bluetooth devices must be paired with the new VCIM. Bluetooth devices that have not been paired to the new VCIM will not function properly. 2. Install the new OnStar(R) module (referred to as the Communication Interface Module (CIM) or Vehicle Communication Interface Module (VCIM) in SI). Refer to SI for module installation instructions. Page 4428 3. Use a small flat-bladed tool to gently pry off the dress cover by inserting the tool under the cover opposite the harness side and prying up. 4. Remove the cover. 5. Using a small flat-bladed tool, push on the side of the nose piece retainer while pushing the nose piece forward with your thumb. This will release the terminal position assurance (TPA). 6. Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) into the corresponding terminal release cavity. The release cavities are the 2 center rows of cavities on one half of the connector. Page 473 It is very important to use the correct test adapter when testing for proper terminal contact of fuses and relays in a bussed electrical center (BEC). Use J-35616-35 to test for proper terminal contact. Failure to use J-35616-35 can result in improper diagnosis of the BEC. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Separate the connector halves. 2. Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body. 3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J-38125 , test that the retention force is significantly different between a good terminal and a suspect terminal. Replace the female terminal in question. FLAT WIRE (DOCK AND LOCK) CONNECTORS There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock) connectors on the harness side or the component side. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Remove the component in question. 2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side of the connector as oil from your skin may be a source of contamination as well. 3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other imperfections that could cause poor terminal contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are uniform and free of damage or deformation. 4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the on the flat wire harness connector in order to test the circuit in question. CONTROL MODULE/COMPONENT VOLTAGE AND GROUNDS Poor voltage or ground connections can cause widely varying symptoms. Test all control module voltage supply circuits. Many vehicles have multiple circuits supplying voltage to a control module. Other components in the system may have separate voltage supply circuits that may also need to be tested. Inspect connections at the module/component connectors, fuses, and any intermediate connections between the voltage source and the module/component. A test lamp or a DMM may indicate that voltage is present, but neither tests the ability of the circuit to carry sufficient current. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Power Distribution Schematics. - Test all control module ground and system ground circuits. The control module may have multiple ground circuits. Other components in the system may have separate grounds that may also need to be tested. Inspect grounds for clean and tight connections at the grounding point. Inspect the connections at the component and in splice packs, where applicable. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Ground Distribution Schematics. TEMPERATURE SENSITIVITY - An intermittent condition may occur when a component/connection reaches normal operating temperature. The condition may occur only when the component/connection is cold, or only when the component/connection is hot. - Freeze Frame, Failure Records, Snapshot, or Vehicle Data Recorder data may help with this type of intermittent condition, where applicable. - If the intermittent is related to heat, review the data for a relationship with the following: High ambient temperatures - Underhood/engine generated heat - Circuit generated heat due to a poor connection, or high electrical load - Higher than normal load conditions, towing, etc. - If the intermittent is related to cold, review the data for the following: Low ambient temperatures-In extremely low temperatures, ice may form in a connection or component. Inspect for water intrusion. - The condition only occurs on a cold start. - The condition goes away when the vehicle warms up. - Information from the customer may help to determine if the trouble follows a pattern that is temperature related. - If temperature is suspected of causing an intermittent fault condition, attempt to duplicate the condition. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required. ELECTROMAGNETIC INTERFERENCE (EMI) AND ELECTRICAL NOISE Some electrical components/circuits are sensitive to electromagnetic interference (EMI) or other types of electrical noise. Inspect for the following conditions: A misrouted harness that is too close to high voltage/high current devices such as secondary ignition components, motors, generator etc-These components may induce electrical noise on a circuit that could interfere with normal circuit operation. - Electrical system interference caused by a malfunctioning relay, or a control module driven solenoid or switch-These conditions can cause a sharp electrical surge. Normally, the condition will occur when the malfunctioning component is operating. - Improper installation of non-factory or aftermarket add on accessories such as lights, 2-way radios, amplifiers, electric motors, remote starters, alarm systems, cell phones, etc-These accessories may lead to interference while in use, but do not fail when the accessories are not in use. - Test for an open diode across the A/C compressor clutch and for other open diodes. Some relays may contain a clamping diode. - The generator may be allowing AC noise into the electrical system. INCORRECT CONTROL MODULE - There are only a few situations where reprogramming a control module is appropriate: A new service control module is installed. Page 5564 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) and slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. Engine/Transmission - Aftermarket Calibrations Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine/Transmission - Aftermarket Calibrations INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 09-06-04-026C Date: August 13, 2010 Subject: Identifying Non-GM (Aftermarket) Engine and Transmission Calibrations for V8 Gas Engines Using Tech 2(R) or Global Diagnostic System (GDS) Models: 2006-2011 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Excluding Saab 9-7X) 2006-2009 HUMMER H2 2006-2010 HUMMER H3 Equipped with V8 Gas Powered Engines Only Attention: This bulletin applies to V8 gas powered engines ONLY. For Duramax(TM) diesel powered engines, refer to the latest version of Corporate Bulletin Number 08-06-04-006G. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2011 model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 09-06-04-026A (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). General Motors is identifying an increasing number of engine, transmission and catalytic converter part failures that are the result of non-GM (aftermarket) engine and transmission control calibrations being used. When alteration to the GM-released engine or transmission control calibrations occurs, it subjects powertrain and driveline components (engine , transmission, transfer case, driveshaft and rear axle) to stresses that were not tested by General Motors. It is because of these unknown stresses, and the potential to alter reliability, durability and emissions performance, that GM has adopted a policy that prevents any UNAUTHORIZED dealer warranty claim submissions to any remaining warranty coverage, to the powertrain and driveline components whenever the presence of a non-GM (aftermarket) calibration is confirmed - even if the non-GM control module calibration is subsequently removed. Warranty coverage is based on the equipment and calibrations that were released on the vehicle at time of sale, or subsequently updated by GM. That's because GM testing and validation matches the calibration to a host of criteria that is essential to assure reliability, durability and emissions performance over the life of the warranty coverage and beyond. Stresses resulting from calibrations different from those tested and released by GM can damage or weaken components, leading to poor performance and or shortened life. Additionally, non-GM (aftermarket) issued engine control modifications often do not meet the same emissions performance standards as GM issued calibrations. Depending on state statutes, individuals who install engine control module calibrations that put the vehicle outside the parameters of emissions certification standards may be subject to fines and/or penalties. This bulletin outlines a procedure to identify the presence of non-GM (aftermarket) calibrations. GM recommends performing this check whenever a hard part failure is seen on internal engine or transmission components, or before an engine assembly or transmission assembly is being replaced under warranty. It is also recommended that the engine calibration verification procedure be performed whenever diagnostics indicate that catalytic converter replacement is indicated. The PQC has a process to confirm the ECM/PCM calibration is GM issued. The PQC will require a picture of the engine calibration verification screen, as outlined in this bulletin, before authorizing any V8 gas powered engine replacement. If a non-GM calibration is found and verification has taken place through GM, the remaining powertrain and driveline warranty will be blocked and notated in GMVIS and the dealership will be notified. This block prevents any UNAUTHORIZED warranty claim submission. 1. Connect the Tech 2(R) to the vehicle. 2. Go to: Diagnostics and build the vehicle. 3. Select: Powertrain. 4. Select: Engine. 5. *Select: Engine Control Module or PCM. 6. *Select: Module ID Information or I/M Information System if the Module ID Information selection is not available. 7. *If "I/M information System" was selected, it may be necessary to select "Vehicle Information" in order to display the calibration information. ‹› If the CVN information is displayed as "N/A", it will be necessary to contact the TCSC to obtain the CVN information. Page 1556 Page 6107 Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. FCI Connectors FCI CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Diagrams Steering Angle Sensor: Diagrams Antilock Brake System Connector End Views Steering Wheel Speed/Position Sensor Steering Wheel Speed/Position Sensor Steering Wheel Speed/Position Sensor Page 6892 IMPORTANT: Ensure that the dress cover and connector body are both in the released position before reassembling. Failure to do so may cause damage to the connector and component. Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (0.64) BOSCH CONNECTORS (0.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While pressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock until the lever is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Pull the rubber boot that covers the wires back to expose the end of the connector dress cover. 4. Place the connector locking lever in the center of the connector. 5. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs that are on the wire end of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover and connector body and pry up. Page 6914 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) and slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. Page 7155 to analyze the data during the time a vehicle condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a trigger point that you have determined. Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2 snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a first-in, first-out basis. If a third snapshot is taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost. Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types: Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice - Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200 frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not lost if the Scan Tool is powered down. The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis. The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected values by plotting 3 parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful, especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC. Testing for a Short to Voltage TESTING FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4. Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt, there is a short to voltage in the circuit. Testing for Continuity TESTING FOR CONTINUITY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6. Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit. 7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity. With a Test Lamp IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits. 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6. If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity. Testing for Electrical Intermittents TESTING FOR ELECTRICAL INTERMITTENTS Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment. - Testing for Short to Ground - Testing for Continuity - Testing for a Short to Voltage Page 8404 View of the connector when released from the component. View of another type of Micro 64 connector. Page 8128 If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200 DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J 39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected. IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J 39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and maximum (MAX) values measured. 1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of a suspected circuit to the other. 2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J 39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep). IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value in order to record the full change. 5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling the connections or the wiring, test driving, or performing other operations. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions. 6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9. Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist. Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections TESTING FOR INTERMITTENT CONDITIONS AND POOR CONNECTIONS TOOLS REQUIRED - J 35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit - J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit When the condition is not currently present, but is indicated in DTC history, the cause may be intermittent. An intermittent may also be the cause when there is a customer complaint, but the symptom cannot be duplicated. Refer to the Symptom Table of the system that is suspect of causing the condition before trying to locate an intermittent condition. Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the following items: Wiring broken inside the insulation - Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector - Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself, and corrosion in the wire to terminal contact area, etc. - Pierced or damaged insulation can allow moisture to enter the wiring causing corrosion. The conductor can corrode inside the insulation, with little visible evidence. Look for swollen and stiff sections of wire in the suspect circuits. - Wiring which has been pinched, cut, or its insulation rubbed through may cause an intermittent open or short as the bare area touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle. - Wiring that comes in contact with hot or exhaust components - Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required, in order to verify the customer concern. - Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. - Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis and Vehicle Data Recorder operation. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any inline connectors before replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation. Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination, usually in the underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit. Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper adapter. Always use the J 35616 when probing connectors. Other causes of terminal deformation are improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT IN BUSSED ELECTRICAL CENTERS (BEC) Page 8278 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the TPA. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the nose piece. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. Page 8453 If a wire is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm, etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except coaxial. - Do not use the DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent American wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 402 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. JST Connectors JST CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, remove the connector from the component. Specifications Piston Ring: Specifications Piston Rings Piston Ring End Gap - First Compression Ring - Measured in Cylinder Bore Production ........................................................................................................................................... ........................ 0.23-0.44 mm (0.009-0.017 in) Service ...................................................................... .................................................................................................. 0.23-0.5 mm (0.009-0.0196 in) Piston Ring End Gap - Second Compression Ring - Measured in Cylinder Bore Production ........................................................................................................................................... .......................... 0.44-0.7 mm (0.017-0.027 in) Service ...................................................................... .................................................................................................. 0.44-0.76 mm (0.0173-0.03 in) Piston Ring End Gap - Oil Control Ring - Measured in Cylinder Bore Production ........................................................................................................................................... ........................ 0.18-0.75 mm (0.007-0.029 in) Service ...................................................................... .................................................................................................. 0.18-0.81 mm (0.007-0.032 in) Piston Ring-to-Groove Clearance - First Compression Ring Production ......................................................................................................................................................... 0.04-0.085 mm (0.00157-0.00335 in) Service .............................................................................................................................................................. 0.04-0.085 mm (0.00157-0.00335 in) Piston Ring-to-Groove Clearance - Second Compression Ring Production ........................................................................................................................................................... 0.04-0.078 mm (0.00157-0.0031 in) Service ....................................................................................... ......................................................................... 0.04-0.078 mm (0.00157-0.0031 in) Piston Ring-to-Groove Clearance - Oil Control Ring Production ........................................................................................................................................... .................... 0.012-0.2 mm (0.0005-0.0078 in) Service ...................................................................... .............................................................................................. 0.012-0.2 mm (0.0005-0.0078 in) Page 1828 Page 7329 MEASURING FREQUENCY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal. IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM to autorange to an appropriate range. 1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency measured. Measuring Voltage MEASURING VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit. 1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods: - Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. - Turn ON the engine. - Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls. - Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested. 3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The DMM displays the voltage measured at that point. Measuring Voltage Drop MEASURING VOLTAGE DROP NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points. Probing Electrical Connectors PROBING ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS Page 2342 Depress the locks that are located on both sides of the wiredress cover and pull the lever over and past the locks. View of the connector when released from the component. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the front of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool push down on one of the locking tabs and pull the cover up until the dress cover releases. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. Diagram Information and Instructions Oxygen Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions Electrical Symbols Page 2262 9. The illustration shows a cutaway view of the connector to aid the technician in releasing the terminal retainer. 10. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Terminal Position Assurance Locks TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Tyco/Amp Connectors (CM 42-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (CM 42-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the connector body and pull the CPA out. The CPA is on the wire harness side of connector. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 7025 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (BSK) BOSCH CONNECTORS (BSK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 3. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 4. Insert the J 38125-561 tool into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 5. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is Page 5482 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert a small flat-blade tool in the slot below the front loaded terminal position assurance (TPA) and pry up. 3. Remove the TPA by pulling it out of the connector. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-553 (GM P/N 15315247) on a slight upward angle into the cavity below the terminal to be removed. Ensure that the pointed on the end of the tool is facing the bottom of the terminal and it stays in contact with the terminal until it stops on the plastic terminal retainer. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 4135 6. Remove the transmission oil cooler line retaining bracket bolt and bracket. 7. Remove the starter. Refer to Starter Motor Replacement (4.2L Engine) Starter Motor Replacement (5.3L and 6.0L Engines). 8. Remove the flywheel inspection cover from the left side of the transmission. 9. Remove the battery cable channel bolt from the front of the oil pan. 10. Remove the battery cable channel from the oil pan. Engine Controls - MIL ON/Misfire/Misfire DTC's Set Ground Strap: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL ON/Misfire/Misfire DTC's Set Bulletin No.: 06-06-04-046 Date: September 12, 2006 INFORMATION Subject: Information on Engine Misfire MIL/SES Light Illuminated or Flashing DTC P0300, P0301, P0302, P0303, P0304, P0305, P0306, P0307, P0308, P0420 or P0430 Models: 1999-2007 Cadillac, Chevrolet, GMC Full-Size Pickup and/or Utility Trucks with 4.8L, 5.3L, 5.7L, 6.0L or 6.2L VORTEC GEN III, GEN IV, V-8 Engine (VINs V, C, T, Z, B, 3, M, 0, J, R, U, N, Y, K, 8 - RPOs LR4, LY2, LM7, L59, L33, LC9, LH6, LMG, LY5, L31, LQ4, LQ9, L76, LY6, L92) with Active Fuel Management(TM) and E85 Flex Fuel If you encounter vehicles that exhibit the above conditions, refer to SI for the appropriate DTC(s) set. If no trouble is found, the cause may be due to an ECM ground terminal that has corroded with rust over time. Inspect the main engine wiring harness ground terminal (G103) for this condition. The wire terminal (G103) attaches either to the front or to the rear of the right side cylinder head, depending on the model year of the Full Size Pickup and/or Utility Trucks. If the ECM ground terminal has been found to be corroded, then follow the service procedure outlined in this bulletin to correct the corrosion issue. Remove either the nut or bolt securing the main engine wiring harness ground terminal (G103) to the right cylinder head. Refer to the above illustration to determine where the ground is located on the vehicle (1). Page 6112 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully raise the TPA on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA cannot be removed from the connector while there are terminals present in the connector body. View of the TPA when removed from the connector body. 4. Use the J 38125-12A tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the left side of the terminal release cavity as shown in the graphic. Use the tool to move the terminal release to the right with a gentle prying motion. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 8670 11. Insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) into the 2 triangular cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 12. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE 1. Prior to installation the terminal must be aligned so the (1) coding lugs align with the (2) coding grooves on the connector. 2. Once the terminal is aligned, slide the terminal into the cavity until the retainer has engaged in the cavity of the connector. 3. Slide the TPA in the connector body and seat it using a small flat bladed tool. The TPA is seated when it is flush with the contact housing. 4. Secure the wires to the connector body using a tie wrap and replace the dress cover and grommet. Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) BOSCH CONNECTORS (2.8 JPT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Pull out the slider on the connector position assurance (CPA) until it is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 5475 4. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the rear of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. 5. Once the locking tabs are unlocked, slide the inner connector out of the rear of the connector housing. Page 3204 17. With the left rear wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve tightened securely, after all air has been purged from the left rear hydraulic circuit, install a proper box-end wrench onto the RIGHT FRONT wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve. 18. Install a transparent hose over the end of the bleeder valve, then repeat steps 13-14. 19. With the right front wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve tightened securely, after all air has been purged from the right front hydraulic circuit, install a proper box-end wrench onto the LEFT FRONT wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve. 20. Install a transparent hose over the end of the bleeder valve, then repeat steps 13-14. 21. After completing the final wheel hydraulic circuit bleeding procedure, ensure that each of the 4 wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valves are properly tightened. 22. Close the J 29532, or equivalent, fluid tank valve, then disconnect the J 29532, or equivalent, from the J 35589-A. 23. Remove the J 35589-A from the brake master cylinder reservoir. 24. Fill the brake master cylinder reservoir to the maximum-fill level with Delco Supreme 11(R), GM P/N 12377967 (Canadian P/N 992667), or equivalent DOT-3 brake fluid from a clean, sealed brake fluid container. 25. Slowly depress and release the brake pedal. Observe the feel of the brake pedal. 26. If the brake pedal feels spongy perform the following steps: 1. Inspect the brake system for external leaks. Refer to Brake System External Leak Inspection. 2. Using a scan tool, perform the antilock brake system automated bleeding procedure to remove any air that may have been trapped in the brake pressure modulator valve (BPMV). Refer to Antilock Brake System Automated Bleed Procedure. 27. Turn the ignition key ON, with the engine OFF. Check to see if the brake system warning lamp remains illuminated. Important: If the brake system warning lamp remains illuminated, DO NOT allow the vehicle to be driven until it is diagnosed and repaired. 28. If the brake system warning lamp remains illuminated, refer to Symptoms - Hydraulic Brakes. Page 975 Control Module: Service and Repair Transmission Control Module Replacement Service of the transmission control module (TCM) should consist of reprogramming of the TCM. If the diagnostic procedures call for the TCM to be replaced, the replacement TCM should be checked to ensure that the correct part is being used. If the correct part is being used, remove the faulty TCM and install the new service TCM. The replacement TCM must be programmed. Removal Procedure 1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. Refer to Battery Negative Cable Disconnection and Connection. 2. Disconnect the cooling fan electrical connector for additional clearance while removing the TCM. 3. Depress the engine control module (ECM)/TCM cover retainers (2). 4. Remove the ECM/TCM cover from the ECM/TCM bracket (1). Notice: Refer to Handling Electrostatic Discharge Sensitive Parts Notice. Important: It is not necessary to disconnect the TCM electrical connectors in order to remove the TCM from the ECM/TCM bracket. Only disconnect the electrical connectors if servicing of component requires disconnecting of the electrical connectors. Important: Remove any debris from around the TCM connector surfaces before servicing the TCM. Inspect the TCM module connector gaskets when diagnosing or replacing the TCM. Ensure that the gaskets are installed correctly. The gaskets prevent contaminant intrusion into the TCM. 5. Disconnect the TCM electrical connector (1) from the TCM (2) Page 1976 3. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. View showing depressing of the lever lock release tab. Page 490 - In some cases Delphi will actually be printed on the connector. If Delphi is not printed on the connector, look for PED. In both cases there is no specific orientation for Delphi or PED and they can appear anywhere on the connector. - FCI connectors may have the FCI logo on their connectors. The logo is the letters FCI with an "A" above it. - JAE connector have JAE in small letters on their connectors. Page 8414 The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors. 1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position. 4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool J 38125-10A (GM P/N 12014012-1) into the front (mating end) of the connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal through the back of the connector (2). IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector. 6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. 7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily. 10. Perform system check. Delphi Connectors (12 Way) DELPHI CONNECTORS (12-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. Wheels/Tires - Refinishing Aluminum Wheels Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels/Tires - Refinishing Aluminum Wheels INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 99-08-51-007E Date: March 17, 2011 Subject: Refinishing Aluminum Wheels Models: 2012 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add additional model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 99-08-51-007D (Section 08 - Body and Accessories). This bulletin updates General Motor's position on refinishing aluminum wheels. GM does not endorse any repairs that involve welding, bending, straightening or re-machining. Only cosmetic refinishing of the wheel's coatings, using recommended procedures, is allowed. Evaluating Damage In evaluating damage, it is the GM Dealer's responsibility to inspect the wheel for corrosion, scrapes, gouges, etc. The Dealer must insure that such damage is not deeper than what can be sanded or polished off. The wheel must be inspected for cracks. If cracks are found, discard the wheel. Any wheels with bent rim flanges must not be repaired or refinished. Wheels that have been refinished by an outside company must be returned to the same vehicle. The Dealer must record the wheel ID stamp or the cast date on the wheel in order to assure this requirement. Refer to Refinisher's Responsibility - Outside Company later in this bulletin. Aluminum Wheel Refinishing Recommendations - Chrome-plated aluminum wheels Re-plating these wheels is not recommended. - Polished aluminum wheels These wheels have a polyester or acrylic clearcoat on them. If the clearcoat is damaged, refinishing is possible. However, the required refinishing process cannot be performed in the dealer environment. Refer to Refinisher's Responsibility - Outside Company later in this bulletin. - Painted aluminum wheels These wheels are painted using a primer, color coat, and clearcoat procedure. If the paint is damaged, refinishing is possible. As with polished wheels, all original coatings must be removed first. Media blasting is recommended. Refer to GM Aluminum Refinishing Bulletin #53-17-03A for the re-painting of this type of wheel. - Bright, machined aluminum wheels These wheels have a polyester or acrylic clearcoat on them. In some cases, the recessed "pocket" areas of the wheel may be painted. Surface refinishing is possible. The wheel must be totally stripped by media blasting or other suitable means. The wheel should be resurfaced by using a sanding process rather than a machining process. This allows the least amount of material to be removed. Important Do not use any re-machining process that removes aluminum. This could affect the dimensions and function of the wheel. Painting is an option to re-clearcoating polished and bright machined aluminum wheels. Paint will better mask any surface imperfections and is somewhat more durable than clearcoat alone. GM recommends using Corsican SILVER WAEQ9283 for a fine "aluminum-like" look or Sparkle SILVER WA9967 for a very bright look. As an option, the body color may also be used. When using any of the painting options, it is recommended that all four wheels be refinished in order to maintain color uniformity. Refer to GM Aluminum Refinishing Bulletin #53-17-03A for specific procedures and product recommendations. Refinisher's Responsibility - Outside Company Important Some outside companies are offering wheel refinishing services. Such refinished wheels will be permanently marked by the refinisher and are warranted by the refinisher. Any process that re-machines or otherwise re-manufactures the wheel should not be used. A refinisher's responsibility includes inspecting for cracks using the Zyglo system or the equivalent. Any cracked wheels must not be refinished. No welding, hammering or reforming of any kind is allowed. The wheel ID must be recorded and follow the wheel throughout the process in order to assure that the same wheel is returned. A plastic media blast may be used for clean up of the wheel. Hand and/or lathe sanding of the machined surface and the wheel window is allowed. Material removal, though, must be kept to a minimum. Re-machining of the wheel is not allowed. Paint and/or clear coat must not be present on the following surfaces: the nut chamfers, the wheel mounting surfaces and the wheel pilot hole. The refinisher must permanently ID stamp the wheel and warrant the painted/clearcoated surfaces for a minimum of one year or the remainder of the new vehicle warranty, whichever is Page 3228 Page 9022 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. 4. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front of the connector. Page 4023 11. Install the shock module. Refer to Shock Module Replacement. 12. Install the engine protection shield. Refer to Engine Protection Shield Replacement. 13. Install the front tire and wheels. Refer to Tire and Wheel Removal and Installation. 14. Lower the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. Page 6715 3. Remove the dress cover by using a flat-blade tool to release the connector locking tabs and pulling off the dress cover. 4. Relieve the tension on the nose piece retainers by inserting J-38125-12A (12094429) into the single retainer slot on the end of the nose piece and gently prying out the locking tab. Repeat the process for both of the nose piece locking tabs on the opposite side of the nose piece. Page 6856 Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Service and Repair Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure Notice: Handle the electronic throttle control components carefully. Use cleanliness in order to prevent damage. Do not drop the electronic throttle control components. Do not roughly handle the electronic throttle control components. Do not immerse the electronic throttle control components in cleaning solvents of any type. 1. Disconnect the accelerator pedal position (APP) sensor electrical connector. 2. Remove the 3 APP sensor bolts (1). 3. Remove the APP sensor (2). Installation Procedure 1. Install the APP sensor. Page 1457 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert terminal into the appropriate terminal holder until it hits bottom and stops. The correct terminal holder is determined by the wire size. Also ensure that the terminals wings are pointing towards the former on the tool and the release locator. 5. Insert the stripped cable into the terminal. Insulation should be visible on both sides of the terminal insulation wings. 6. Compress the handles until the ratchet automatically releases. 7. Place the terminal into the appropriate cavity and assemble the connector. Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO-PACK 100W) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W connectors. These connectors are very similar but use different terminals and have some minor physical differences also. Page 8814 TERMINAL REMOVAL Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors. 1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA) device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1). 3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 4. Gently pull the cable and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector. 5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal, refer to Terminal Repair. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3. Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector. REINSTALLING TERMINAL 1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly, refer to Wiring Repairs. 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3. Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) DELPHI CONNECTORS (WEATHER PACK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 8745 Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Bank 2 Sensor 1 Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Bank 2 Sensor 2 Page 1365 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. 4. Remove the dress cover by using a flat bladed tool to release the dress cover locking tabs and lift up on the dress cover. 5. Cut the tie wrap that holds the wires to the connector body. Page 2100 View of connector in released position. 4. Disconnect the connector from the component. 5. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Release the rear lower half of the wiredress cover. Page 7947 - HVAC Actuator - Inflatable Restraint Sensing and Diagnostic Module (SDM) - Any AIR BAG module - Seatbelt Lap Anchor Pretensioner - Seatbelt Retractor Pretensioner - An SIR system connection or connector condition resulting in the following DTCs being set: B0015, B0016, B0019, B0020, B0022, or B0023 - Powertrain Control Module (PCM) - Remote Control Door Lock Receiver (RCDLR) - Transmission Control Module (TCM) Correction Important DO NOT replace the control module, wiring or component for the following conditions: - The condition is intermittent and cannot be duplicated. - The condition is present and by disconnecting and reconnecting the connector the condition can no longer be duplicated. Use the following procedure to correct the conditions listed above. 1. Install a scan tool and perform the Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle. Retrieve and record any existing history or current DTCs from all of the control modules (refer to SI). ‹› If any DTC(s) are set, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle to identify the connector(s) of the control module/component which may be causing the condition (refer to SI). ‹› If DTCs are not set, refer to Symptoms - Vehicle to identify the connector(s) of the control module/component which may be causing the condition (refer to SI). 2. When identified, use the appropriate DTC Diagnostics, Symptoms, Schematics, Component Connector End Views and Component Locator documents to locate and disconnect the affected harness connector(s) which are causing the condition. Note Fretting corrosion looks like little dark smudges on electrical terminals and appear where the actual electrical contact is being made. In less severe cases it may be unable to be seen or identified without the use of a magnifying glass. Important DO NOT apply an excessive amount of dielectric lubricant to the connectors as shown, as hydrolock may result when attempting to mate the connectors. Use ONLY a clean nylon brush that is dedicated to the repair of the conditions in this bulletin. 3. With a one-inch nylon bristle brush, apply dielectric lubricant to both the module/component side and the harness side of the affected connector(s). 4. Reconnect the affected connector(s) and wipe away any excess lubricant that may be present. 5. Attempt to duplicate the condition by using the following information: - DTC Diagnostic Procedure - Circuit/System Description - Conditions for Running the DTC - Conditions for Setting the DTC - Diagnostic Aids - Circuit/System Verification ‹› If the condition cannot be duplicated, the repair is complete. ‹› If the condition can be duplicated, then follow the appropriate DTC, Symptom or Circuit/System Testing procedure (refer to SI). Repair Order Documentation Page 5920 Oil Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Engine Oil Pressure Sensor and/or Switch Replacement Tools Required J 41712 Oil Pressure Switch Socket Removal Procedure 1. Remove the intake manifold. Refer to Intake Manifold Replacement. 2. Disconnect the oil pressure sensor electrical connector (1). 3. Using J 41712 or equivalent, remove the oil pressure sensor. Installation Procedure Page 5975 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Ensure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the Terminal Removal Procedure. Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PULL TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL If the terminal is visibly damaged or is suspected of having a faulty connection, the terminal should be replaced. Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors: 1. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) device and/or the secondary lock. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component or separate the connectors for in-line connectors. 3. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device. 4. Insert the proper pick or removal tool into the front of the connector body. 5. IMPORTANT: On connectors with more than one terminal the service loop may not be large enough to remove the terminal and crimp on a new one. If the terminal wire does not have a large enough service loop for removal, cut the wire 5 cm (2 in) behind the connector before removal. Grasp the wire at the back of the connector body and gently push the terminal out the front of the connector body. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. If the wire needed to be cut in order to remove the terminal, gently push a small length of the same size wire through the back of the connector cavity until there is enough wire exposed in order to crimp on a new terminal. If the wire was not cut, cut the existing wire as close to the old terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 4. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. TERMINAL INSTALLATION 1. Align the terminal and pull the wire from the back of the connector in order to seat the terminal. 2. If necessary, cut the new wire to proper length and splice with existing circuit. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. 3. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply dielectric grease to the connector. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PUSH TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 5919 For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 7009 Page 2169 Open the harness by removing any tape. 2. Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. 3. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 4. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent american wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 5. Slide a section of high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing down the length of wire to be spliced. Ensure that the shrink tubing will not interfere with the splice procedure. 6. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 7. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. 8. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 9. Insert the wire into the DuraSeal splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 10. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Page 3120 The information has been updated within SI. If you are using a paper version of this Service Manual, please make a reference to this bulletin on the affected page. Disclaimer Page 5769 Important: Never reuse the old seal or a fuel leak may occur. Always use a NEW seal. 1. Install a NEW seal (3) onto the fuel tank. Important: Place the fuel pump strainer in a horizontal position when you install the fuel sender in the tank. When installing the fuel sender assembly, assure that the fuel pump strainer does not block full travel of the float arm. 2. Install the fuel sender assembly (2). Important: Always replace the fuel sender seal when installing the fuel sender assembly. Replace the lock ring if necessary. Do not apply any type of lubrication in the seal groove. Ensure the lock ring is installed with the correct side facing upward. A correctly installed lock ring will only turn in a clockwise direction. 3. Use the J45722 in order to install the fuel sender lock ring. Turn the fuel sender lock ring in a clockwise direction. Page 4884 Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay: Diagnostic Aids Arrows and Symbols Arrows and Symbols This Service Data uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations. Arrows and Symbols 1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow Basic Knowledge Required GENERAL ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures contained in the service manual. You should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current (amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram, as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. Decimal and Metric Equivalents Decimal and Metric Equivalents Page 8522 3. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. View showing depressing of the lever lock release tab. Page 7465 Page 410 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. 4. Remove the dress cover by using a flat bladed tool to release the dress cover locking tabs and lift up on the dress cover. 5. Cut the tie wrap that holds the wires to the connector body. Page 534 2. Use a small flat-bladed tool to release the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting the tool in the small recess on the side of the connector and pushing up until the TPA releases from the connector body. The TPA should raise just slightly. Do not try to remove the TPA. IMPORTANT: The TPA on this connector cannot be removed unless the terminals are removed first. The TPA will come out of the connector body, but only slightly. When the TPA is slightly raised the terminals can be removed. Using excessive force to remove the TPA with the terminals still in the connector will damage the connector. 3. Repeat the process for the other side of the connector. 4. Ensure that the TPA is in the proper position to remove the terminals. Page 9081 View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. 4. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers CIRCUIT PROTECTION - CIRCUIT BREAKERS A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types of circuit Fastener Tightening Specifications Alignment: Specifications Fastener Tightening Specifications Fastener Tightening Specifications Fastener Tightening Specifications Page 1696 All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system. Page 6845 Spark Plug: Service and Repair Spark Plug Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Remove the spark plug wire. 2. Remove the washer solvent container to gain access to the #2 spark plug. 3. Loosen the spark plug 1-2 turns. 4. Brush or using compressed air, blow away any dirt from around the spark plug. 5. Remove the spark plug. If removing more than one plug, place each plug in a tray marked with the corresponding cylinder number. Installation Procedure Page 6326 - Most Molex connectors will have the Molex logo on the dresscover of the connector. In some cases the connectors may have MX followed by another letter. The third letter indicates where the connector was made. A connector with MXD is a Molex connector made in Detroit. Sumitomo has a unique symbol on their connector and possibly a part number. The symbol is similar to that of a diamond lying on its side, similar to that shown. The logo could appear anywhere but the most common place is at the wire side of the housing. Tyco/AMP has many different and unique connector designs. Some may or may not have identifiable marks on them. Locations Underhood Lamp Switch: Locations Liftgate OnStar(R) - Number Incorrect/Incorrectly Assigned Emergency Contact Module: Customer Interest OnStar(R) - Number Incorrect/Incorrectly Assigned INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 05-08-46-004C Date: December 23, 2010 Subject: OnStar(R) Phone Number Concerns (Phone Number Incorrect/Assigned to Another Vehicle/Phone) That Occur During Diagnosis of OnStar(R) System Models: 2000-2011 GM Passenger Cars and Trucks Equipped with OnStar(R) (RPO UE1) Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update model years up to 2011. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 05-08-46-004B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories). During diagnosis of an OnStar(R) concern, the technician may be told that the OnStar(R) phone number is incorrect or tied to another vehicle and/or phone of some kind. To resolve these concerns, the Tech 2(R) with software version 22.005 (or higher), has the capability to change the OnStar(R) phone number. Service Procedure 1. With the Tech 2(R), build the vehicle to specifications within the Diagnostics area of the Tech 2(R). 2. For vehicles with physical-based diagnostics - under Body, go to the OnStar(R) section. Then select the Special Functions menu. For vehicles with functional-based diagnostics - under Body and Accessories, go to the Cellular Communication section. Select Module Setup and then Vehicle Communication Interface Module. 3. Locate the Program Phone Number prompt and select it. The original phone number will be displayed on the Tech 2(R) screen. 4. Contact the OnStar(R) team at the GM Technical Assistance Center (TAC) to obtain a new phone number. 5. Highlight the digits of the phone number one at a time and enter the new phone number using the number keys on the Tech 2(R). 6. Press the Soft key at the base of the screen for Done once these numbers have been changed on the screen. 7. Press the Soft key for Done again. The area code or new phone number has now been programmed into the phone. 8. Cycle the ignition to Off and open the driver's door. 9. Press the blue OnStar(R) button to make sure that a normal connection can be made to the OnStar(R) call center. If applicable, make sure the Hands-Free Calling (HFC) works properly by making a phone call. 10. If the system is working properly, fax or voicemail a case closing into the OnStar(R) team at TAC with the results. Dealers in Canada should submit case closing information through the GM infoNET. Please follow this diagnostic process thoroughly and complete each step. If the condition exhibited is resolved WITHOUT completing every step, the remaining steps do not need to be performed. If the procedure above does not resolve the condition, you must contact TAC for further assistance. This diagnostic approach was developed specifically for this condition and should not automatically be used for other vehicles with similar symptoms. Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use: Warranty Information (Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Page 516 View of typical connector. View of connector in released position. 1. Locate the assist lever at the back of the connector. Move the assist lever to the rear position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the dress cover. Page 4627 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the TPA. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the nose piece. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. Page 8779 IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals. Front probe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the connector. IMPORTANT: When probing female 0.64 terminals, it is important to use the correct adapter. There have been some revisions to the test adapter for 0.64 terminals. The proper adapter for 0.64 terminals is the J 35616-64B which has a gold terminal and a black wire between the base and tip. Failure to use the proper test adapter may result in damage to the terminal being tested and improper diagnosis. NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Page 6225 TERMINAL REMOVAL Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors. 1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA) device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1). 3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 4. Gently pull the cable and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector. 5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal, refer to Terminal Repair. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3. Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector. REINSTALLING TERMINAL 1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly, refer to Wiring Repairs. 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3. Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) DELPHI CONNECTORS (WEATHER PACK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 7233 If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs SIR/SRS WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS, and the wiring components, such as connectors and terminals. IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system terminals. Use either an SIR/SRS pigtail or a terminated lead from the SIR Repair Kit Tray. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves, in order to repair the SIR/SRS wiring - A special crimping tool - A heat torch - An instruction manual The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides the necessary low resistance contact integrity for these sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors SIR/SRS CONNECTOR REPAIR (PLASTIC BODY AND TERMINAL METAL PIN) The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made with a special plating. This plating provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. Use the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit for repairing SIR/SRS terminals and connectors. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the repair kit. The J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit contains: Various terminated leads for sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) terminal replacement - Various connector positive assurance (CPA) locks for SIR/SRS connectors - Base of steering column pigtail connectors part number 12085514 - Yellow vinyl electrical tape Pigtail repair packs are available for SIR/SRS connectors with eight or less terminals. Only the connector body is available for connectors with more than eight terminals. The terminated leads in the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit can be used to replace damaged terminals when replacing the connector body. SIR/SRS COMPONENT WIRE PIGTAIL REPAIR IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails. A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device, not by a connector. If a wiring pigtail is damaged, you must replace the entire component, with pigtail. The inflatable restraint steering wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component. SIR/SRS WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 2433 - A control module from another vehicle is installed. - Revised software/calibration files have been released for this vehicle. - IMPORTANT: DO NOT re-program the control module with the SAME software/calibration files that are already present in the control module. This is not an effective repair for any type of concern. Verify that the control module contains the correct software/calibration. If incorrect programming is found, reprogram the control module with the most current software/calibration. Refer to Control Module References for replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Testing for Short to Ground TESTING FOR SHORT TO GROUND NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 4. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit. With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is a short to ground in the circuit. Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2. Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). - When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. - If the DMM does not display voltage 4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is shorted. Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A DIGITAL MULTIMETER NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the powertrain control module (PCM), should only be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200 Digital Multimeter (DMM). The J 39200 instruction manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminage even though voltage is present. The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity. IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading. Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the measurement. Page 3197 Refrigerant Oil: Fluid Type Specifications PAG Oil GM P/N 12345923 (Canadian P/N 10953486) Page 99 For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 1444 6. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs located on the opposite side of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover at the connector end and pry up. 7. Remove the dress cover. 8. Cut the tie wrap on the wire bundle. 9. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting a small flat-bladed tool into the small slot in the end of the slider and pushing on the TPA until it comes out of the connector. When the TPA exits the opposite side of the connector, gasp the TPA and pull it completely out of the connector. 10. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 536 Release the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the blue locking tabs on both ends of the connector. Gently slide the TPA up to the released position on both ends. 6. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-13A (GM P/N 12031876-1) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. Page 4137 14. Remove the oil pan bolts. 15. Remove the oil pan by tilting the rear of the oil pan down to clear the transmission, pull the oil pan rearward past the front wire harness, then lower the oil pan clear of the vehicle. Important: ^ The oil pan gasket is reusable. It is NOT necessary to remove the oil pan gasket unless damaged. ^ DO NOT allow foreign material to enter the oil passages of the oil pan, cap or cover the openings as required. Drill out the oil pan gasket retaining rivets (2), if required. 16. Remove the gasket (1) from the pan. 17. Discard the gasket and rivets. 18. Clean and inspect the oil pan. Refer to Oil Pan Cleaning and Inspection. Installation Procedure Important: ^ The alignment of the structural oil pan is critical. The rear bolt hole locations of the oil pan provide mounting points for the transmission bellhousing. To ensure the rigidity of the powertrain and correct transmission alignment, it is important that the rear of the block and the rear of the oil pan must NEVER protrude beyond the engine block and transmission bellhousing plane. ^ If replacing the oil pan gasket it is not necessary to rivet the NEW gasket to the oil pan. Page 4012 Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Install the A/C belt tensioner bolts. Tighten the bolts to 50 N.m (37 lb ft). 3. Lower the vehicle. 4. Install the A/C drive belt. Refer to Drive Belt Replacement - Air Conditioning. Restraints - Air Bag Lamp ON/Multiple DTC Set Air Bag Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Restraints - Air Bag Lamp ON/Multiple DTC Set TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 08-09-41-002F Date: June 10, 2010 Subject: Diagnostic Information for Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System, Intermittent AIR BAG Indicator/Lamp Illuminated with DTC(s) B0012, B0013, B0015, B0016, B0019, B0020, B0022, B0023, B0026, B0033, B0040, B0042 or B0044 Set (Inspect and Replace Connector Position Assurance (CPA) Retainer) Models: 2005-2007 Buick Rainier 2006-2009 Buick Allure (Canada only), LaCrosse, Lucerne 2008-2010 Buick Enclave 2006-2010 Cadillac DTS 2007-2010 Cadillac Escalade Models 2008-2009 Cadillac SRX, XLR 2008-2010 Cadillac CTS, STS 2005-2006 Chevrolet SSR 2005-2009 Chevrolet TrailBlazer, TrailBlazer EXT 2005-2010 Chevrolet Cobalt 2006-2007 Chevrolet Monte Carlo 2006-2010 Chevrolet Corvette, HHR, Impala, Malibu Models (includes Malibu Classic) 2007-2009 Chevrolet Equinox 2007-2010 Chevrolet Avalanche, Silverado, Suburban, Tahoe 2008-2010 Chevrolet Express 2009-2010 Chevrolet Traverse 2005-2009 GMC Envoy Models 2007-2010 GMC Acadia, Sierra, Yukon, Yukon Denali, Yukon XL, Yukon Denali XL 2008-2010 GMC Savana 2005-2006 Pontiac Pursuit 2005-2009 Pontiac G6 2006-2009 Pontiac Solstice 2007-2009 Pontiac G5, Torrent 2008-2009 Pontiac G8 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X 2007-2009 Saturn AURA, OUTLOOK, SKY 2008-2009 Saturn VUE 2008-2009 HUMMER H2 2007-2008 Daewoo G2X 2007-2009 Opel GT Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the Warranty Information and add Saab Warranty Information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 08-09-41-002E (Section 09 Restraints). Condition - Some customers may comment on an intermittent or current AIR BAG indicator or lamp being illuminated on the instrument panel cluster (IPC). Important This bulletin only applies to the following DTCs: - Technicians may observe DTC(s) B0012 04, 0D, 0E; B0013 04, 0D, 0E; B0015 04, 0D, 0E; B0016 04, 0D, 0E; B0019 04, 0D, 0E; B0020 04, 0D, 0E; B0022, B0023 04, 0D, 0E; B0033 04, 0D, 0E; B0040 04, 0D, 0E; B0042 or B0044 set as Current or in History in the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM). Cause This condition may be caused by a loose, missing, or damaged connector position assurance (CPA) retainer at a supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) module electrical connector, or a deployment loop wiring harness electrical connector. Correction Page 1238 Combination Switch: Diagrams Turn Signal/Multifunction Switch C1 Page 3350 Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Specifications Fuel Pressure: Specifications Fuel Pressure (Key ON, Engine OFF).................................................................................................. ..............................................345-414 kPa (50-60 psi) Page 6749 Diagram Information and Instructions Knock Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions Electrical Symbols Page 1647 If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs SIR/SRS WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS, and the wiring components, such as connectors and terminals. IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system terminals. Use either an SIR/SRS pigtail or a terminated lead from the SIR Repair Kit Tray. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves, in order to repair the SIR/SRS wiring - A special crimping tool - A heat torch - An instruction manual The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides the necessary low resistance contact integrity for these sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors SIR/SRS CONNECTOR REPAIR (PLASTIC BODY AND TERMINAL METAL PIN) The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made with a special plating. This plating provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. Use the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit for repairing SIR/SRS terminals and connectors. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the repair kit. The J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit contains: Various terminated leads for sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) terminal replacement - Various connector positive assurance (CPA) locks for SIR/SRS connectors - Base of steering column pigtail connectors part number 12085514 - Yellow vinyl electrical tape Pigtail repair packs are available for SIR/SRS connectors with eight or less terminals. Only the connector body is available for connectors with more than eight terminals. The terminated leads in the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit can be used to replace damaged terminals when replacing the connector body. SIR/SRS COMPONENT WIRE PIGTAIL REPAIR IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails. A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device, not by a connector. If a wiring pigtail is damaged, you must replace the entire component, with pigtail. The inflatable restraint steering wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component. SIR/SRS WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 7760 Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested: - Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. - Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a component or to other harnesses. - If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A TEST LAMP TOOLS REQUIRED J 35616-200 Test Light - Probe Kit NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminate even though voltage is present. The J 35616-200 is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair of leads. To properly operate this tool use the following procedures. When testing for voltage: 1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested. When testing for ground: 1. Attach one lead to battery positive voltage. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where ground should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is ground at the point being tested. Using Connector Test Adapters USING CONNECTOR TEST ADAPTERS NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Using Fused Jumper Wires USING FUSED JUMPER WIRES TOOLS REQUIRED J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged. The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested. AFL/ECP Connectors AFL/EPC CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Locations Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Locations Fuse Block - Underhood (5.3L/6.0L), Label Page 7928 Tighten Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb in). Note The repair area MUST BE properly refinished to maintain a secure, stable and corrosion-free electrical ground. 12. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and Repair in SI. 13. Verify proper system operation. M8 Weld Nut Caution Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground repair. 1. If the M8 weld nut electrical ground location is accessible from both sides of the panel, a M8 conductive bolt and a M8 conductive nut may be used to secure the electrical ground wire terminal. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 2. Select a location adjacent the M8 weld nut having 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance behind the panel surface and 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance surrounding the new electrical ground site. 3. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the surface surrounding the ground location and allow to dry. Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled. 4. Drill a 10 mm (0.40 in) diameter hole through the panel. 5. Remove paint and primer from the area surrounding the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole until bare metal is visible. 6. Select a M8 conductive bolt. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 7. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M8 conductive bolt. Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase. 8. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground wire terminal. 9. Install the electrical ground wire terminal and the M8 conductive bolt to the ground location. 10. Select a M8 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 11. Install the M8 conductive nut to the bolt and: Tighten Tighten to 22 Nm (16 lb ft). Note The repair area MUST BE properly refinished to maintain a secure, stable and corrosion-free electrical ground. 12. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and Repair in SI. 13. Verify proper system operation. M8 Weld Nut Alternative Repair Caution Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground repair. 1. If the M8 weld nut electrical ground location is not accessible from both sides of the panel, a M6 conductive rivet stud and a M6 conductive nut may be used to secure the electrical ground wire terminal. 2. Select a location adjacent the damaged M8 weld nut having 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance behind the panel surface and 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance surrounding the M6 conductive rivet stud flange. 3. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the repair site and allow to dry. Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled. 4. Drill a 10 mm (0.40 in) diameter hole through the panel. Page 3527 Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 3. Install the sensor nut and position the sensor body parallel to the inside wheel surface while torquing. Tighten the sensor nut to 7 N.m (62 lb in). Important: Before reinstalling the tire on the wheel, note the following items to avoid tire pressure sensor damage upon tire mounting. ^ Position the mounting/dismounting head 180 degrees from the valve stem. ^ Position the bead transition area 45 degrees counterclockwise of the valve stem. ^ Using the tire machine, rotate the tire/wheel assembly clockwise when transferring the tire bead to the inside of the wheel rim. ^ Repeat items for outer bead. Install the tire on the wheel. Refer to Tire Mounting and Dismounting. Important: A service replacement tire pressure sensor is shipped in OFF mode. In this mode the sensor's unique identification code cannot be learned into the passenger door modules (PDMs) memory. The sensor must be taken out of OFF mode by spinning the tire/wheel assembly above 32 km/h (20 mph) in order to close the sensors internal roll switch for at least 10 seconds. 4. Install the tire/wheel assembly on the vehicle. Refer to Tire and Wheel Removal and Installation. 5. Lower the vehicle. 6. Learn the tire pressure sensors. Refer to Tire Pressure Sensor Learn. Page 5153 MEASURING FREQUENCY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal. IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM to autorange to an appropriate range. 1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency measured. Measuring Voltage MEASURING VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit. 1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods: - Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. - Turn ON the engine. - Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls. - Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested. 3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The DMM displays the voltage measured at that point. Measuring Voltage Drop MEASURING VOLTAGE DROP NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points. Probing Electrical Connectors PROBING ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS Page 6878 Refer to the following table as a guide in selecting the correct test adapter for front probing connectors: Backprobe IMPORTANT: Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures. - Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector. - Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large of a test probe. - After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected, test for proper terminal contact. Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the connector. Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure SCAN TOOL SNAPSHOT PROCEDURE Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used Page 7494 Connector Anatomy Connector Repairs contains a list of all connector repairs. The connector repairs are listed by the connector manufacturer and then by connector type. If the technician cannot identify the manufacturer of the connector, refer to Identifying Connectors below. Knowing the connector manufacturer will assist in finding the correct connector repair from the following list: - Connector Position Assurance Locks - Terminal Position Assurance Locks - Bosch Connectors (0.64) Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) Bosch Connectors (BSK) Bosch Connectors (ECM) - Delphi Connectors (Micro.64) Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) Delphi Connectors (12-Way) - Tyco/AMP Connectors (CM 42-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) Tyco/AMP Connectors (025 Cap) Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) - Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) - Repairing Connector Terminals IDENTIFYING CONNECTORS Knowing the connector manufacturer is helpful when trying to locating the correct connector repair procedure. There are many different connector designs used on GM vehicles and it is sometimes difficult to identify the connector manufacturer. The information in this document should help with the identification of connector manufactures. The following connector manufacturers make most of the connectors found in GM vehicles: AFL/EPC (Alcoa Fujikura Ltd./Engineered Plastics Components) - Bosch - Delphi - FCI (Framatome Connectors International) - JAE (Japan Aviation Electronics) - JST (Japan Solderless Terminals) Page 8055 View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. View of the release tool being used for the smaller terminals. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (2-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 7769 IMPORTANT: Ensure that the dress cover and connector body are both in the released position before reassembling. Failure to do so may cause damage to the connector and component. Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (0.64) BOSCH CONNECTORS (0.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While pressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock until the lever is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Pull the rubber boot that covers the wires back to expose the end of the connector dress cover. 4. Place the connector locking lever in the center of the connector. 5. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs that are on the wire end of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover and connector body and pry up. Locations Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Locations Engine Controls Component Views Accelerator and Brake Pedals 1 - Instrument Panel Harness 2 - Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor 3 - Accelerator Pedal 4 Brake Pedal 5 - Stop Lamp Switch Page 5003 7. Wrap electrical tape around the connection as shown. 8. Route the engine coolant heater cord and extension cord behind the alternator and adjacent to the engine coolant crossover pipe as shown. 9. Continue to route the extension cord to the exit location desired by the customer as shown. 10. Review the routing of the coolant heater cord and extension cord to verify that it does not touch any sharp edges that could damage it. 11. Secure the engine coolant heater cord and the extension cord with tie straps as needed. 12. Resecure any of the original clips that retained the engine coolant heater cord to the vehicle that were released to provide length. Part Information The extension cord may be obtained at any of the following outlets: - Lowes* - Home Depot* - Canada: Acklands-Grainger* (www.acklandsgrainger.com), Catalogue Part Number: CWRSJTOW3C14-10 USA: Cords should bear the UL symbol. Canada: Cords should bear the ULc symbol or CSA approval. *We believe these sources and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume any responsibility for the products or material from these firms or for any such items that may be available from other sources. Page 8673 - Kostel - Molex - Sumitomo - Tyco/AMP - Yazaki Identifying the manufacturer of a connector is often difficult. When trying to determine the manufacturer of a connector, look for specific identifying marks that are unique to that connector supplier. Most of these identify marks are hard to find or see. Check the connector carefully and refer to the information below for pictures and descriptions of connector identification markings. - Most of AFLs connectors have EPC on their connector body. Some of the smaller connectors will not have any markings on them. - In some cases Bosch will actually be printed on the connector. If Bosch does not appear on the connector, look for the Bosch logo. The Bosch logo is a circle with a blunted arrow inside. This logo can appear anywhere on the connector and is often very small. Page 3255 5. Insert the J 38125-557 (GM P/N 12122378) into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 6. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Connector Position Assurance Locks CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of the connector. CPAs are used in various connectors throughout the vehicle. CPAs are also used in all SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals, of the connector. Connector Repairs CONNECTOR REPAIRS Page 3340 Page 6714 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 2780 Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair Park/Neutral Position Switch Replacement Tools Required J 41364-A Park/Neutral Switch Aligner Removal Procedure 1. Apply the parking brake. 2. Shift the transmission into neutral. 3. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 4. Remove the nut securing the transmission control lever to the manual shaft. 5. Remove the transmission control lever from the manual shaft. 6. Disconnect the electrical connectors from the switch. 7. Remove the bolts securing the park/neutral position switch to the transmission. 8. Remove the park/neutral position switch from the manual shaft. If the park/neutral position switch did not slide off the manual shaft, file the outer edge of the manual shaft in order to remove any burrs. Installation Procedure 1. Install the switch to the transmission manual shaft by aligning the switch hub flats with the manual shaft flats. 2. Slide the switch onto the transmission manual shaft until the switch mounting bracket contacts the mounting bosses on the transmission. Important: If a new switch is being installed, the switch will come with a positive assurance bracket. The positive assurance bracket aligns the new switch in it proper position for installation and the use of neutral position adjustment tool will not be necessary. 3. Install the switch to the transmission with 2 bolts finger tight. Page 4800 - Kostel - Molex - Sumitomo - Tyco/AMP - Yazaki Identifying the manufacturer of a connector is often difficult. When trying to determine the manufacturer of a connector, look for specific identifying marks that are unique to that connector supplier. Most of these identify marks are hard to find or see. Check the connector carefully and refer to the information below for pictures and descriptions of connector identification markings. - Most of AFLs connectors have EPC on their connector body. Some of the smaller connectors will not have any markings on them. - In some cases Bosch will actually be printed on the connector. If Bosch does not appear on the connector, look for the Bosch logo. The Bosch logo is a circle with a blunted arrow inside. This logo can appear anywhere on the connector and is often very small. Page 7495 - Kostel - Molex - Sumitomo - Tyco/AMP - Yazaki Identifying the manufacturer of a connector is often difficult. When trying to determine the manufacturer of a connector, look for specific identifying marks that are unique to that connector supplier. Most of these identify marks are hard to find or see. Check the connector carefully and refer to the information below for pictures and descriptions of connector identification markings. - Most of AFLs connectors have EPC on their connector body. Some of the smaller connectors will not have any markings on them. - In some cases Bosch will actually be printed on the connector. If Bosch does not appear on the connector, look for the Bosch logo. The Bosch logo is a circle with a blunted arrow inside. This logo can appear anywhere on the connector and is often very small. Page 4656 View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. View of the release tool being used for the smaller terminals. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (2-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 7908 Note The dealer will receive an e-mail reply after the calibrations have been validated. The e-mail reply will advise the dealer if the calibrations are OEM. 28. Allow two hours for the PQC to verify the calibrations and set up the case details. ‹› If the PQC determines that the calibrations ARE aftermarket calibrations, DO NOT contact GM Technical Assistance to discuss warranty concerns on the aftermarket calibrations. ALL questions and concerns about warranty should be directed to the dealers Fixed Operations Manager (FOM), (Warranty Manager (WM) in Canada). 29. You may call the PQC two hours after submitting the e-mail for authorization to replace the assembly. This will provide them time to receive, review and set up a case on the request. Please be prepared to provide all the usual documentation that is normally required when requesting an assembly authorization from the PQC. Warranty Information - The Dealership Service Management must be involved in any situation that would justify the use of labor operation Z1111. - Notify the Fixed Operations Manager (FOM) (Warranty Manager (WM) in Canada) of the situation. - All claims will have to be routed to the FOM (WM in Canada) for approval. - Please refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 09-00-89-016, Labor Operation Z1111 - Suspected Tampering or Vehicle Modifications for important information. For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table above. Disclaimer Page 6243 8. Insert the J 38125-213 into the small terminal release hole on the nose piece and gently pull on the back of the wire. 9. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Repairing Connector Terminals REPAIRING CONNECTOR TERMINALS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following: Push to Seat terminals - Pull to Seat terminals Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your terminal repair. The J-38125 contains further information. 1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.For cable seal terminals, remove the seal. 2. Apply the correct cable seal per gage size of the wire, if used.Slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation removal. 3. Remove the insulation. 4. For sealed terminals only, align the seal with the end of the cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal.For sealed terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal. 6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.For sealed terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable. 8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals excepting Micro-Pack 100.64 size. Soldering Micro-Pack 100 World terminals may damage the terminal. Sumitomo Connectors SUMITOMO CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit OnStar(R) - Aftermarket Device Interference Information Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Aftermarket Device Interference Information INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 08-08-46-004 Date: August 14, 2008 Subject: Information on Aftermarket Device Interference with OnStar(R) Diagnostic Services Models: 2009 and Prior GM Passenger Car and Truck (including Saturn) 2009 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3 Models 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X with OnStar(R) (RPO UE1) This bulletin is being issued to provide dealer service personnel with information regarding aftermarket devices connected to the Diagnostic Link Connector (DLC) and the impact to OnStar(R) diagnostic probes and Vehicle Diagnostic e-mails. Certain aftermarket devices, when connected to the Diagnostic Link Connector, such as, but not limited to, Scan Tools, Trip Computers, Fuel Economy Analyzers and Insurance Tracking Devices, interfere with OnStar's ability to perform a diagnostic probe when requested (via a blue button call) by a subscriber. These devices also prohibit the ability to gather diagnostic and tire pressure data for a subscriber's scheduled OnStar(R) Vehicle Diagnostic (OVD) e-mail. These aftermarket devices utilize the Vehicles serial data bus to perform data requests and/or information gathering. When these devices are requesting data, OnStar(R) is designed not to interfere with any data request being made by these devices as required by OBD II regulations. The OnStar(R) advisor is unable to definitively detect the presence of these devices and will only be able to inform the caller or requester of the unsuccessful or incomplete probe and may in some cases refer the subscriber/requester to take the vehicle to a dealer for diagnosis of the concern. When performing a diagnostic check for an unsuccessful or incomplete OnStar(R) diagnostic probe, or for concerns regarding completeness of the OnStar(R) Vehicle Diagnostic (OVD) e-mail, verify that an aftermarket device was not present at the time of the requested probe. Regarding the OVD e-mail, if an aftermarket device is interfering (including a Scan Tool of any type), the e-mail will consistently display a "yellow" indication in diagnostics section for all vehicle systems except the OnStar(R) System and Tire Pressure data (not available on all vehicles) will not be displayed (i.e. section is collapsed). Successful diagnostic probes and complete OVD e-mails will resume following the removal or disconnecting of the off-board device. Disclaimer Page 1743 Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. FCI Connectors FCI CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 4053 Allow at least a two hour soak time between engine OFF and start up when evaluating the tick noise. 2. Start the engine and evaluate the valve lifter tick noise. ‹› If the valve lifter tick noise is still present, replace all 16 valve lifters. Refer to Valve Lifter Replacement in SI. Parts Information Note A V8 AFM engine requires 8 AFM lifters and 8 non-AFM lifters for a total of 16 lifters. Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use: Warranty Information (Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 5241 5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape. Seat Belt Schematic Icons Seat Belt Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons Page 5257 Notice: Refer to Handling Electrostatic Discharge Sensitive Parts Notice. Important: * It is not necessary to disconnect the ECM electrical connectors in order to remove the ECM from the ECM/TCM bracket. Only disconnect the electrical connectors if servicing of component requires disconnecting of the electrical connectors. * Remove any debris from around the ECM connector surfaces before servicing the ECM. Inspect the ECM module connector gaskets when diagnosing or replacing the ECM. Ensure that the gaskets are installed correctly. The gaskets prevent contaminant intrusion into the ECM. Disconnect the engine wiring harness electrical connectors from the ECM. 6. Release the ECM/TCM bracket upper retainers (1). 7. Tilt the ECM away from the bracket and remove the ECM. Page 4008 Drive Belt Tensioner: Testing and Inspection Drive Belt Tensioner Diagnosis Inspection Procedure Notice: Allowing the drive belt tensioner to snap into the free position may result in damage to the tensioner. Important: When the engine is operating the drive belt tensioner arm will move. Do not replace the drive belt tensioner because of movement in the drive belt tensioner arm. 1. Remove the drive belt. Refer to Drive Belt Replacement - Accessory or to Drive Belt Replacement - Air Conditioning. 2. Move the drive belt tensioner through its full travel. ^ The movement should feel smooth. ^ There should be no binding. ^ The tensioner should return freely. 3. If any binding is observed, replace the drive belt tensioner. Refer to Drive Belt Tensioner Replacement - Accessory or to Drive Belt Tensioner Replacement - Air Conditioning. 4. Install the drive belt. Refer to Drive Belt Replacement - Accessory or to Drive Belt Replacement Air Conditioning. Page 3502 Vehicle Lifting: Service and Repair Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle Caution: To avoid any vehicle damage, serious personal injury or death when major components are removed from the vehicle and the vehicle is supported by a hoist, support the vehicle with jack stands at the opposite end from which the components are being removed and strap the vehicle to the hoist. Caution: To avoid any vehicle damage, serious personal injury or death, always use the jackstands to support the vehicle when lifting the vehicle with a jack. Notice: Perform the following steps before beginning any vehicle lifting or jacking procedure: * Remove or secure all of the vehicle's contents in order to avoid any shifting or any movement that may occur during the vehicle lifting or jacking procedure. * The lifting equipment or the jacking equipment weight rating must meet or exceed the weight of the vehicle and any vehicle contents. * The lifting equipment or the jacking equipment must meet the operational standards of the lifting equipment or jacking equipment's manufacturer. * Perform the vehicle lifting or jacking procedure on a clean, hard, dry, level surface. * Perform the vehicle lifting or jacking procedure only at the identified lift points. DO NOT allow the lifting equipment or jacking equipment to contact any other vehicle components. Failure to perform the previous steps could result in damage to the lifting equipment or the jacking equipment, the vehicle, and/or the vehicle's contents. Vehicle Lifting * Ensure that the lifting equipment meets weight requirements and is in good working order. Always follow the lift manufacturer's instructions. * You may lift and support the front of the vehicle at the front suspension near the wheel assemblies. Ensure that the arms of the front cradle are extended as close to the steering knuckle as possible. * Ensure that the vehicle is centered on the hoist before attempting to lift. * When using a suspension-contact hoist, ensure that the rear cradle has adequate clearance for the rear stabilizer bar. Page 6953 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Start in the middle and gradually move the heat barrel to the open ends of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Heated Oxygen Sensor Wiring Repairs HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being obstructed. If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. - Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks, etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire. - Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance. - To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector. Page 8391 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. 4. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front of the connector. Page 6260 6. Gently pry the plastic terminal retainer down and carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (16-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, pull the two connector halves apart. Page 7539 3. Ensure that the terminal release tang access panel is in the correct location to access the terminals. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) into the terminal release tang access slot located behind the access panel of the connector and press down on the terminal while carefully pulling the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Tyco/AMP Connectors (0.25 Cap) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (025 CAP) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component by pressing down on the connector position assurance (CPA). Page 8795 6. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs located on the opposite side of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover at the connector end and pry up. 7. Remove the dress cover. 8. Cut the tie wrap on the wire bundle. 9. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting a small flat-bladed tool into the small slot in the end of the slider and pushing on the TPA until it comes out of the connector. When the TPA exits the opposite side of the connector, gasp the TPA and pull it completely out of the connector. 10. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 7178 View of a typical Micro 64 connector. Depress the lock and pull the lever over and past the lock. Page 6549 - JST connectors have JST in small letters on their connectors, similar to that above. The location of the logo will vary with the connector size and style. - Kostel has an "LK" with a circle around it. These connector are usually used as a transmissions connection and are currently use on some Cadillac vehicles. Page 2620 3. Use a small flat-bladed tool to gently pry off the dress cover by inserting the tool under the cover opposite the harness side and prying up. 4. Remove the cover. 5. Using a small flat-bladed tool, push on the side of the nose piece retainer while pushing the nose piece forward with your thumb. This will release the terminal position assurance (TPA). 6. Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) into the corresponding terminal release cavity. The release cavities are the 2 center rows of cavities on one half of the connector. Page 6054 Page 1312 vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide variety of actions, including: - Wiggling the harness - Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting - Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector - Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation - Relocating a harness or wires All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. Another option is, with the component commanded ON and OFF by the scan tool, move related connectors and wiring and observe the component operation. With the engine running, move related connectors and wiring while monitoring engine operation. If harness or connector movement affects the data displayed, component/system operation, or engine operation, inspect and repair the harness/connections as necessary. You may need to load the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these cases you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide good results as well. There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions, along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the circuit to these kinds of conditions. SALT WATER SPRAY Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture. Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5 percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously. HIGH TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070. Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault condition. The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis. This option does not allow for the same control, however. LOW TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect. If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to -18°C (0°F) from one end and +71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized cooling needs. Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or components in an effort to duplicate the concern. DUPLICATING FAILURE CONDITIONS - If none of the previous tests are successful, attempt to duplicate and/or capture the failure conditions. Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, where applicable, contains the conditions that were present when the DTC set. 1. Review and record Freeze Frame/Failure Records data. 2. Clear the DTCs using the scan tool. 3. Turn the key to OFF and wait 15 seconds. 4. Operate the vehicle under the same conditions that were noted in Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, as closely as possible. The vehicle must also be operating within the Conditions for Running the DTC. Refer to Conditions for Running the DTC in the supporting text if a DTC is being diagnosed. 5. Monitor DTC Status for the DTC being tested. The scan tool will indicate Ran, when the enabling conditions have been satisfied long enough for the DTC to run. The scan tool will also indicate whether the DTC passed or failed. - An alternate method is to drive the vehicle with the DMM connected to a suspected circuit. An abnormal reading on the DMM when the concern occurs, may help you locate the concern. Measuring Frequency Page 7876 Body Control Module: Service and Repair Body Control Module Replacement BODY CONTROL MODULE REPLACEMENT REMOVAL PROCEDURE IMPORTANT: The ignition switch should be in the OFF position when connecting or disconnecting the connectors to the body control module (BCM). - Always disconnect the 40-way body wiring extension FIRST, the 32-way tan connector SECOND and the 24-way gray electrical connector LAST. - Always connect the 24-way gray electrical connector FIRST, the 32-way tan connector SECOND and the 40-way body wiring extension LAST. - The BCM can set DTCs with the ignition switch in the OFF position. The BCM has battery run down protection for the courtesy lamp circuit. The BCM battery run down protection cannot detect shorts on inputs or other circuits which the BCM does not control. Use the scan tool in order to activate the POWER DOWN NOW mode. Use the POWER DOWN NOW mode in order to check for current draws on circuits that are not controlled by the BCM, or controlled by the battery run down protection system. - Do not touch the exposed electrical contacts of the body wiring extension. Do not open the BCM housing. The module does not have any serviceable components. The module may be replaced only as an assembly. 1. CAUTION: Refer to Battery Disconnect Caution. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. If replacing the BCM on a Chevrolet TrailBlazer EXT or GMC Envoy XL, remove the left second row seat. 3. If replacing the BCM on a Chevrolet TrailBlazer or GMC Envoy, position the left hand second seat to a cargo position. 4. Remove the rear electrical center cover. 5. Press down and hold the locking tab (1). 6. Disengage the sliding latch retaining the BCM to the rear electrical center.Slide the latch inboard until fully extended, approximately 40 mm (1.6 in). 7. Disconnect the 40-way body wiring extension (1) from the BCM. Page 5572 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully raise the TPA on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA cannot be removed from the connector while there are terminals present in the connector body. View of the TPA when removed from the connector body. 4. Use the J 38125-12A tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the left side of the terminal release cavity as shown in the graphic. Use the tool to move the terminal release to the right with a gentle prying motion. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 6451 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) and slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. Locations Camshaft Position Sensor: Locations Engine Controls Component Views Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor 1 - Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor 2 - C110 Page 2321 Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested: - Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. - Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a component or to other harnesses. - If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A TEST LAMP TOOLS REQUIRED J 35616-200 Test Light - Probe Kit NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminate even though voltage is present. The J 35616-200 is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair of leads. To properly operate this tool use the following procedures. When testing for voltage: 1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested. When testing for ground: 1. Attach one lead to battery positive voltage. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where ground should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is ground at the point being tested. Using Connector Test Adapters USING CONNECTOR TEST ADAPTERS NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Using Fused Jumper Wires USING FUSED JUMPER WIRES TOOLS REQUIRED J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged. The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested. AFL/ECP Connectors AFL/EPC CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 2626 2. Use a small flat-bladed tool to release the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting the tool in the small recess on the side of the connector and pushing up until the TPA releases from the connector body. The TPA should raise just slightly. Do not try to remove the TPA. IMPORTANT: The TPA on this connector cannot be removed unless the terminals are removed first. The TPA will come out of the connector body, but only slightly. When the TPA is slightly raised the terminals can be removed. Using excessive force to remove the TPA with the terminals still in the connector will damage the connector. 3. Repeat the process for the other side of the connector. 4. Ensure that the TPA is in the proper position to remove the terminals. Page 5209 3. Remove the dress cover by using a flat-blade tool to release the connector locking tabs and pulling off the dress cover. 4. Relieve the tension on the nose piece retainers by inserting J-38125-12A (12094429) into the single retainer slot on the end of the nose piece and gently prying out the locking tab. Repeat the process for both of the nose piece locking tabs on the opposite side of the nose piece. Page 3234 Checking Aftermarket Accessories CHECKING AFTERMARKET ACCESSORIES Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits: - CAUTION: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol. - NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice. OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol. Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the cause of the problems. Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include: Power feeds connected to points other than the battery - Antenna location - Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring - Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line - Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories. Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions INDUCING INTERMITTENT FAULT CONDITIONS TOOLS REQUIRED J 25070 Heat Gun Many intermittent open or shorted circuits are affected by harness/connector movement that is caused by vibration, engine torque, bumps/rough pavement, etc. In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness if the malfunction appears to be Page 2362 View of typical connector. View of connector in released position. 1. Locate the assist lever at the back of the connector. Move the assist lever to the rear position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the dress cover. Page 7699 Page 6420 Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested: - Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. - Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a component or to other harnesses. - If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A TEST LAMP TOOLS REQUIRED J 35616-200 Test Light - Probe Kit NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminate even though voltage is present. The J 35616-200 is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair of leads. To properly operate this tool use the following procedures. When testing for voltage: 1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested. When testing for ground: 1. Attach one lead to battery positive voltage. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where ground should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is ground at the point being tested. Using Connector Test Adapters USING CONNECTOR TEST ADAPTERS NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Using Fused Jumper Wires USING FUSED JUMPER WIRES TOOLS REQUIRED J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged. The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested. AFL/ECP Connectors AFL/EPC CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 2986 11. Grasp firmly while pulling down with a twisting motion in order to remove the filter. 12. Remove the filter seal. The filter seal may be stuck in the pump. If necessary, carefully use pliers or another suitable tool to remove the seal. 13. Discard the seal. 14. Inspect the fluid color. 15. Inspect the filter. Pry the metal crimping away from the top of the filter and pull apart. The filter may contain the following evidence for root cause diagnosis: ^ Clutch material ^ Bronze slivers indicating bushing wear ^ Steel particles 16. Clean the transmission case and the oil pan gasket surfaces with solvent, and air dry. You must remove all traces of the old gasket material. Installation Procedure 1. Coat the new filter seal with automatic transmission fluid. 2. Install the new filter seal into the transmission case. Tap the seal into place using a suitable size socket. 3. Install the new filter into the case. Page 886 Release the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the blue locking tabs on both ends of the connector. Gently slide the TPA up to the released position on both ends. 6. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-13A (GM P/N 12031876-1) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. Page 2711 For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 748 2. Use a small flat-bladed tool to release the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting the tool in the small recess on the side of the connector and pushing up until the TPA releases from the connector body. The TPA should raise just slightly. Do not try to remove the TPA. IMPORTANT: The TPA on this connector cannot be removed unless the terminals are removed first. The TPA will come out of the connector body, but only slightly. When the TPA is slightly raised the terminals can be removed. Using excessive force to remove the TPA with the terminals still in the connector will damage the connector. 3. Repeat the process for the other side of the connector. 4. Ensure that the TPA is in the proper position to remove the terminals. Page 6058 Page 7827 breakers are used. CIRCUIT BREAKER This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high current is removed. POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) CIRCUIT BREAKER This type greatly increases its resistance when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker will re-close within a second or 2. Circuit Protection - Fuses CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSES The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and examine the element in the fuse for an open (2). If not broken (1), also check for continuity using a DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one of equal current rating. Circuit Protection - Fusible Links CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSIBLE LINKS Page 179 MEASURING FREQUENCY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal. IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM to autorange to an appropriate range. 1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency measured. Measuring Voltage MEASURING VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit. 1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods: - Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. - Turn ON the engine. - Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls. - Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested. 3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The DMM displays the voltage measured at that point. Measuring Voltage Drop MEASURING VOLTAGE DROP NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points. Probing Electrical Connectors PROBING ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS Page 4531 8. Insert the J 38125-213 into the small terminal release hole on the nose piece and gently pull on the back of the wire. 9. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Repairing Connector Terminals REPAIRING CONNECTOR TERMINALS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following: Push to Seat terminals - Pull to Seat terminals Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your terminal repair. The J-38125 contains further information. 1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.For cable seal terminals, remove the seal. 2. Apply the correct cable seal per gage size of the wire, if used.Slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation removal. 3. Remove the insulation. 4. For sealed terminals only, align the seal with the end of the cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal.For sealed terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal. 6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.For sealed terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable. 8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals excepting Micro-Pack 100.64 size. Soldering Micro-Pack 100 World terminals may damage the terminal. Sumitomo Connectors SUMITOMO CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 3617 10. Align the inscribed mark on the tire with the valve stem on the wheel. 11. Reinstall the Tire Pressure Sensor. Refer to Tire Pressure Sensor installation procedure in SI. 12. Mount the tire on the wheel. Refer to Tire Mounting and Dismounting. 13. Pressurize the tire to 276 kPa (40 psi) and inspect for leaks. 14. Adjust tire pressure to meet the placard specification. 15. Balance the tire/wheel assembly. Refer to Tire and Wheel Assembly Balancing - Off-Vehicle. 16. Install the tire and wheel assembly onto the vehicle. Refer to the appropriate service procedure in SI. Parts Information Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models) Important The Silicone - Adhesive/Sealant comes in a case quantity of six. ONLY charge warranty one tube of adhesive/sealant per wheel repair. For vehicles repaired under warranty, use: One leak repair per wheel. Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table above. Disclaimer Page 3879 7. Rotate the crankshaft until the number one piston is at top dead center (TDC) of the compression stroke. In this position, cylinder number one rocker arms will be off lobe lift, and the crankshaft sprocket key will be at the 1:30 position. The engine firing order is 1, 8, 7, 2, 6, 5, 4, 3. Cylinders 1, 3, 5 and 7 are the left bank. Cylinder 2, 4, 6 and 8 are the right bank. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 8. With the engine in the number one firing position, tighten the following valve rocker arm bolts: ^ Tighten cylinders 1, 2, 7 and 8 exhaust valve rocker arm bolts to 30 N.m (22 lb ft). ^ Tighten cylinders 1, 3, 4 and 5 intake valve rocker arm bolts to 30 N.m (22 lb ft). 9. Rotate the crankshaft 360 degrees. 10. Tighten the following valve rocker arm bolts: ^ Tighten cylinders 3, 4, 5 and 6 exhaust valve rocker arm bolts to 30 N.m (22 lb ft). ^ Tighten cylinders 2, 6, 7 and 8 intake valve rocker arm bolts to 30 N.m (22 lb ft). 11. Install the valve rocker arm cover. Refer to Valve Rocker Arm Cover Replacement - Left Side or to Valve Rocker Arm Cover Replacement - Right Side. Page 9034 View of a typical Micro 64 connector. Depress the lock and pull the lever over and past the lock. Engine - Valve Lifter Tick Noise At Start Up Engine Oil: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Valve Lifter Tick Noise At Start Up TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 10-06-01-007C Date: February 09, 2011 Subject: Active Fuel Management (AFM) Engine, Valve Lifter Tick Noise at Start Up When Engine Has Been Off for 2 Hours or More (Evaluate Noise and/or Replace Valve Lifters) Models: 2007 Buick Rainier 2009 Buick LaCrosse Super, Allure Super (Canada Only) 2007 Cadillac Escalade Built Prior to April 1, 2006 with 6.2L Engine RPO L92 (These engines were built with AFM Hardware but the AFM system was disabled) 2010-2011 Cadillac Escalade, Escalade ESV, Escalade EXT 2007 Chevrolet Monte Carlo 2007-2009 Chevrolet Impala 2007-2011 Chevrolet Avalanche, Silverado, Suburban, Tahoe, TrailBlazer, TrailBlazer EXT 2010-2011 Chevrolet Camaro SS 2007-2011 GMC Envoy, Envoy XL, Sierra, Yukon, Yukon Denali, Yukon XL, Yukon XL Denali 2007-2008 Pontiac Grand Prix 2008-2009 Pontiac G8 2007-2009 Saab 9-7X Equipped with AFM (Active Fuel Management) and V8 Engine RPO L76, L94, L99, LC9, LFA, LH6, LMG, LS4, LY5 or LZ1 Attention: This bulletin only applies to the AFM V8 engines listed above. It DOES NOT apply to Non-AFM Engines. If you are dealing with a Non-AFM engine that is experiencing a similar noise, please refer to Engine Mechanical > Diagnostic Information and Procedures > Symptoms in SI. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add models. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 10-06-01-007B (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). Condition Some customers may comment on an engine valve lifter tick noise that occurs after the engine has been shut off for at least two hours. The tick noise may last from two seconds to ten minutes. Cause This condition may be caused by any of the following: - Aerated oil in the valve lifter body, resulting in the valve lifter being unable to purge the air quickly. - A low engine oil level or incorrect oil viscosity. - Dirty or contaminated oil. - A low internal valve lifter oil reservoir level. - Debris in the valve lifter. - A high valve lifter leak down rate. Correction If the SI diagnostics do not isolate the cause of this valve lifter tick noise and normal oil pressure is noted during the concern, perform the following steps: 1. Inspect the engine oil condition and level. Refer to Owner Manual > Service and Appearance Care > Checking Things Under the Hood > Description and Operation > Engine Oil in SI. ‹› If the engine oil is more than one quart low, an incorrect oil viscosity is being used or if poor quality/contamination is observed, change the oil and filter. Note Page 2094 If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200 DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J 39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected. IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J 39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and maximum (MAX) values measured. 1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of a suspected circuit to the other. 2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J 39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep). IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value in order to record the full change. 5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling the connections or the wiring, test driving, or performing other operations. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions. 6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9. Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist. Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections TESTING FOR INTERMITTENT CONDITIONS AND POOR CONNECTIONS TOOLS REQUIRED - J 35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit - J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit When the condition is not currently present, but is indicated in DTC history, the cause may be intermittent. An intermittent may also be the cause when there is a customer complaint, but the symptom cannot be duplicated. Refer to the Symptom Table of the system that is suspect of causing the condition before trying to locate an intermittent condition. Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the following items: Wiring broken inside the insulation - Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector - Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself, and corrosion in the wire to terminal contact area, etc. - Pierced or damaged insulation can allow moisture to enter the wiring causing corrosion. The conductor can corrode inside the insulation, with little visible evidence. Look for swollen and stiff sections of wire in the suspect circuits. - Wiring which has been pinched, cut, or its insulation rubbed through may cause an intermittent open or short as the bare area touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle. - Wiring that comes in contact with hot or exhaust components - Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required, in order to verify the customer concern. - Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. - Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis and Vehicle Data Recorder operation. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any inline connectors before replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation. Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination, usually in the underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit. Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper adapter. Always use the J 35616 when probing connectors. Other causes of terminal deformation are improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT IN BUSSED ELECTRICAL CENTERS (BEC) Page 3284 View of typical connector. View of connector in released position. 1. Locate the assist lever at the back of the connector. Move the assist lever to the rear position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the dress cover. Page 449 Page 812 All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system. Page 8439 2. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 4894 It is very important to use the correct test adapter when testing for proper terminal contact of fuses and relays in a bussed electrical center (BEC). Use J-35616-35 to test for proper terminal contact. Failure to use J-35616-35 can result in improper diagnosis of the BEC. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Separate the connector halves. 2. Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body. 3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J-38125 , test that the retention force is significantly different between a good terminal and a suspect terminal. Replace the female terminal in question. FLAT WIRE (DOCK AND LOCK) CONNECTORS There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock) connectors on the harness side or the component side. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Remove the component in question. 2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side of the connector as oil from your skin may be a source of contamination as well. 3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other imperfections that could cause poor terminal contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are uniform and free of damage or deformation. 4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the on the flat wire harness connector in order to test the circuit in question. CONTROL MODULE/COMPONENT VOLTAGE AND GROUNDS Poor voltage or ground connections can cause widely varying symptoms. Test all control module voltage supply circuits. Many vehicles have multiple circuits supplying voltage to a control module. Other components in the system may have separate voltage supply circuits that may also need to be tested. Inspect connections at the module/component connectors, fuses, and any intermediate connections between the voltage source and the module/component. A test lamp or a DMM may indicate that voltage is present, but neither tests the ability of the circuit to carry sufficient current. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Power Distribution Schematics. - Test all control module ground and system ground circuits. The control module may have multiple ground circuits. Other components in the system may have separate grounds that may also need to be tested. Inspect grounds for clean and tight connections at the grounding point. Inspect the connections at the component and in splice packs, where applicable. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Ground Distribution Schematics. TEMPERATURE SENSITIVITY - An intermittent condition may occur when a component/connection reaches normal operating temperature. The condition may occur only when the component/connection is cold, or only when the component/connection is hot. - Freeze Frame, Failure Records, Snapshot, or Vehicle Data Recorder data may help with this type of intermittent condition, where applicable. - If the intermittent is related to heat, review the data for a relationship with the following: High ambient temperatures - Underhood/engine generated heat - Circuit generated heat due to a poor connection, or high electrical load - Higher than normal load conditions, towing, etc. - If the intermittent is related to cold, review the data for the following: Low ambient temperatures-In extremely low temperatures, ice may form in a connection or component. Inspect for water intrusion. - The condition only occurs on a cold start. - The condition goes away when the vehicle warms up. - Information from the customer may help to determine if the trouble follows a pattern that is temperature related. - If temperature is suspected of causing an intermittent fault condition, attempt to duplicate the condition. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required. ELECTROMAGNETIC INTERFERENCE (EMI) AND ELECTRICAL NOISE Some electrical components/circuits are sensitive to electromagnetic interference (EMI) or other types of electrical noise. Inspect for the following conditions: A misrouted harness that is too close to high voltage/high current devices such as secondary ignition components, motors, generator etc-These components may induce electrical noise on a circuit that could interfere with normal circuit operation. - Electrical system interference caused by a malfunctioning relay, or a control module driven solenoid or switch-These conditions can cause a sharp electrical surge. Normally, the condition will occur when the malfunctioning component is operating. - Improper installation of non-factory or aftermarket add on accessories such as lights, 2-way radios, amplifiers, electric motors, remote starters, alarm systems, cell phones, etc-These accessories may lead to interference while in use, but do not fail when the accessories are not in use. - Test for an open diode across the A/C compressor clutch and for other open diodes. Some relays may contain a clamping diode. - The generator may be allowing AC noise into the electrical system. INCORRECT CONTROL MODULE - There are only a few situations where reprogramming a control module is appropriate: A new service control module is installed. Page 7067 8. Insert the J 38125-213 into the small terminal release hole on the nose piece and gently pull on the back of the wire. 9. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Repairing Connector Terminals REPAIRING CONNECTOR TERMINALS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following: Push to Seat terminals - Pull to Seat terminals Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your terminal repair. The J-38125 contains further information. 1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.For cable seal terminals, remove the seal. 2. Apply the correct cable seal per gage size of the wire, if used.Slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation removal. 3. Remove the insulation. 4. For sealed terminals only, align the seal with the end of the cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal.For sealed terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal. 6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.For sealed terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable. 8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals excepting Micro-Pack 100.64 size. Soldering Micro-Pack 100 World terminals may damage the terminal. Sumitomo Connectors SUMITOMO CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 6438 - Yazaki has a wedge or arrow shape, similar to that shown. Delphi Connectors (Micro .64) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro 64 connectors. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. The lever lock may be located on the top or sides of the wire dress cover. Page 1388 Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size. REPAIRING A FUSIBLE LINK IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient overload protection. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. Flat Wire Repairs FLAT WIRE REPAIRS NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced. GMLAN Wiring Repairs GMLAN WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The GM Local Area Network (GMLAN) System requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working on GMLAN connectors and terminals. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items in order to repair the GMLAN wiring: Dura Seal splice sleeves - A wire stripping tool - J 38125-8 Crimping Tool (GM P/N 12085115) - J 38125-5 Ultra Torch Special Tool (GM P/N 12085116) The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. - A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors GMLAN REPAIRS IMPORTANT: When making a repair to any GMLAN network, the original wire length after the repair must be the same length as before the repair. If the network is a twisted pair, the twist must be maintained after the repair is completed. GMLAN has 2 types of networks, low speed and high speed. Low speed GMLAN has a single wire and works at slow speeds. High speed GMLAN has 2 wires in a twisted pair and works at higher speeds. For more information on GMLAN, refer to Data Link Communications Description and Operation. GMLAN CONNECTOR TERMINAL REPAIR IMPORTANT: A service terminal can be used to replace damaged connector terminals for both high speed and low speed GMLAN systems. When making a connector terminal repair on a GMLAN high speed system with twisted pair wires, do not untwist the wires more than necessary to make the repair. The terminals in the GMLAN system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are available in the J-38125. If the individual terminals are damaged on any GMLAN connection, use the appropriate connector repair procedure in order to repair the terminal. GMLAN WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 7195 4. Use a small flat-blade tool to slide the terminal position assurance (TPA) up one notch on both ends of the connector. The TPA is located underneath the wire dress cover. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 772 Page 825 Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested: - Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. - Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a component or to other harnesses. - If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A TEST LAMP TOOLS REQUIRED J 35616-200 Test Light - Probe Kit NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminate even though voltage is present. The J 35616-200 is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair of leads. To properly operate this tool use the following procedures. When testing for voltage: 1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested. When testing for ground: 1. Attach one lead to battery positive voltage. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where ground should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is ground at the point being tested. Using Connector Test Adapters USING CONNECTOR TEST ADAPTERS NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Using Fused Jumper Wires USING FUSED JUMPER WIRES TOOLS REQUIRED J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged. The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested. AFL/ECP Connectors AFL/EPC CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 1908 5. While pushing the terminal forward, insert the J 38125-24 in the release cavity above the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (43-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Page 3251 5. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove TPA from the connector. 6. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Page 4929 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the TPA. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the nose piece. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. Page 8558 2. Locate the two indents of the terminal position assurance (TPA) located on the bottom of the connector body. Page 4706 Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Locations Engine Controls Component Views Left Side of Engine - Front 1 - Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor 2 - G108 Page 2273 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert a small flat-blade tool in the slot below the front loaded terminal position assurance (TPA) and pry up. 3. Remove the TPA by pulling it out of the connector. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-553 (GM P/N 15315247) on a slight upward angle into the cavity below the terminal to be removed. Ensure that the pointed on the end of the tool is facing the bottom of the terminal and it stays in contact with the terminal until it stops on the plastic terminal retainer. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 6656 Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Page 1675 Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Diagrams Engine Controls Connector End Views Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor Page 2431 If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200 DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J 39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected. IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J 39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and maximum (MAX) values measured. 1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of a suspected circuit to the other. 2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J 39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep). IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value in order to record the full change. 5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling the connections or the wiring, test driving, or performing other operations. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions. 6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9. Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist. Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections TESTING FOR INTERMITTENT CONDITIONS AND POOR CONNECTIONS TOOLS REQUIRED - J 35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit - J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit When the condition is not currently present, but is indicated in DTC history, the cause may be intermittent. An intermittent may also be the cause when there is a customer complaint, but the symptom cannot be duplicated. Refer to the Symptom Table of the system that is suspect of causing the condition before trying to locate an intermittent condition. Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the following items: Wiring broken inside the insulation - Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector - Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself, and corrosion in the wire to terminal contact area, etc. - Pierced or damaged insulation can allow moisture to enter the wiring causing corrosion. The conductor can corrode inside the insulation, with little visible evidence. Look for swollen and stiff sections of wire in the suspect circuits. - Wiring which has been pinched, cut, or its insulation rubbed through may cause an intermittent open or short as the bare area touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle. - Wiring that comes in contact with hot or exhaust components - Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required, in order to verify the customer concern. - Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. - Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis and Vehicle Data Recorder operation. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any inline connectors before replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation. Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination, usually in the underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit. Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper adapter. Always use the J 35616 when probing connectors. Other causes of terminal deformation are improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT IN BUSSED ELECTRICAL CENTERS (BEC) Page 838 Connector Anatomy Connector Repairs contains a list of all connector repairs. The connector repairs are listed by the connector manufacturer and then by connector type. If the technician cannot identify the manufacturer of the connector, refer to Identifying Connectors below. Knowing the connector manufacturer will assist in finding the correct connector repair from the following list: - Connector Position Assurance Locks - Terminal Position Assurance Locks - Bosch Connectors (0.64) Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) Bosch Connectors (BSK) Bosch Connectors (ECM) - Delphi Connectors (Micro.64) Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) Delphi Connectors (12-Way) - Tyco/AMP Connectors (CM 42-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) Tyco/AMP Connectors (025 Cap) Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) - Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) - Repairing Connector Terminals IDENTIFYING CONNECTORS Knowing the connector manufacturer is helpful when trying to locating the correct connector repair procedure. There are many different connector designs used on GM vehicles and it is sometimes difficult to identify the connector manufacturer. The information in this document should help with the identification of connector manufactures. The following connector manufacturers make most of the connectors found in GM vehicles: AFL/EPC (Alcoa Fujikura Ltd./Engineered Plastics Components) - Bosch - Delphi - FCI (Framatome Connectors International) - JAE (Japan Aviation Electronics) - JST (Japan Solderless Terminals) Page 1382 View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. View of the release tool being used for the smaller terminals. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (2-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 2122 2. Locate the nose piece locking tabs that are positioned on the side of the connector nose piece. The connector nose piece acts as a terminal positive assurance (TPA) and may be referred to as such. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to push in one of the locking tabs while gently pulling on the same side of the nose piece. 4. Repeat the procedure for the other locking tab and remove the nose piece. 5. Remove the wire dress cover. The following is a general procedure for wire dress cover removal. Use this procedure as a guide, some dress cover removal procedures may vary. 6. Use fingers to squeeze the 2 locking legs of the cover. Crankshaft Position Sensor Replacement Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Crankshaft Position Sensor Replacement Crankshaft Position Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure Important: Perform Crankshaft Position System Variation Learn whenever the crankshaft position (CKP) sensor is removed or replaced. 1. Remove the starter. 2. Disconnect the electrical connector (2) from the CKP sensor (1). 3. Clean the area around the CKP sensor before removal in order to avoid debris from entering the engine. 4. Remove the CKP sensor bolt. 5. Remove the CKP sensor. Installation Procedure Page 6135 View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. View of the release tool being used for the smaller terminals. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (2-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 1530 under pressure if the radiator cap or the surge tank cap is removed while the engine and radiator are still hot. 4. Remove the surge tank fill cap from the surge tank or the coolant pressure cap from the radiator. 5. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle in SI. 6. Place a clean drain pan under the radiator drain cock or under the lower radiator hose depending on the vehicle. Refer to Cooling System Draining and Filling in SI. 7. Loosen the radiator drain cock if equipped or use J 38185 clamp pliers and reposition the clamp on the lower radiator hose at the radiator. 8. Remove the end of the lower radiator hose from the radiator. 9. Drain the engine coolant sufficiently below the level of the ECT sensor. 10. Close the radiator drain cock or connect the lower radiator hose at the radiator. 11. Use the J 38185 clamp pliers to place the clamp into the original position on the hose. 12. Lower the vehicle. 13. Disconnect the wiring harness connector from the ECT sensor (2). 14. Remove the ECT sensor (1) from the front of the cylinder head. 15. Remove the corresponding size plug at the rear of the OTHER cylinder head. 16. Coat the threads of the ECT sensor with sealer. Use GM P/N 12346004 (Canadian P/N 10953480) or an equivalent. 17. Install the ECT sensor in the hole of the cylinder head where the plug was removed. Tighten Tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb ft). 18. Coat the threads of the plug with sealer. Use GM P/N 12346004 (Canadian P/N 10953480) or an equivalent. 19. Install the plug in the hole of the cylinder head where the ECT sensor was removed Tighten Tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb ft). Important Leave enough wire attached to the ECT sensor harness connector in order to create manageable splices that are at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splice. Page 5537 Release the tabs that are holding the wiredress cover to the connector body. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the slots on both ends of the connector body. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. J 38125-216 can also be used to remove the nose piece. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by lifting the terminal retaining tabs on the inside of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 2978 Air Filter Element: Service and Repair Air Cleaner Element Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Remove the air cleaner outlet duct. 2. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF)/intake air temperature (IAT) sensor electrical connector (1). 3. Remove the radiator support diagonal brace. 4. Loosen the 4 air cleaner cover retaining screws (1). 5. Remove the air cleaner housing cover (2). Lift and rotate the cover in order to remove the cover from the vehicle. 6. Remove the air filter element (6) and the MAF/IAT sensor (3) from the lower air cleaner housing/washer solvent tank assembly (4). 7. Separate the air filter element (6) from the MAF/IAT sensor (3). 8. Inspect the entire assembly for dust, debris, or water. Clean or replace as necessary. Installation Procedure Page 7649 4. Use a small flat-blade tool to slide the terminal position assurance (TPA) up one notch on both ends of the connector. The TPA is located underneath the wire dress cover. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 3463 Fuse Block - Underhood C2 Page 6283 1. Locate the air flow direction arrow (2) on the MAF/IAT sensor. 2. Install the MAF/IAT sensor on to the air cleaner housing. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 3. Tighten the clamp securing the MAF/IAT sensor to the air cleaner housing. Tighten the clamp to 7 N.m (62 lb in). 4. Install the air cleaner outlet duct. 5. Install the air cleaner outlet duct bolt. Tighten the bolt to 10 N.m (89 lb in). 6. Tighten the clamps at the MAF/IAT sensor and the throttle body. Tighten the clamps to 7 N.m (62 lb in). Campaign - Possible Fuel Sender Port Fracture Fuel Gauge Sender: All Technical Service Bulletins Campaign - Possible Fuel Sender Port Fracture Subject: Service Update for Inventory and Customer Vehicles-Fuel Sending Unit Port Fracture-Extended Start/Sluggish Acceleration/Check Engine Light-Expires with Base Warranty # 07005 - (02/16/2007) Models: 2007 Buick Rainier 2007 Chevrolet TrailBlazer 2007 GMC Envoy 2007 Saab 9-7X THIS SERVICE UPDATE INCLUDES VEHICLES IN DEALER INVENTORY AND CUSTOMER VEHICLES THAT RETURN FOR ANY TYPE OF SERVICE, AND WILL EXPIRE AT THE END OF THE INVOLVED VEHICLE'S NEW VEHICLE LIMITED WARRANTY PERIOD. Purpose This bulletin provides a service procedure to determine if a fuel tank sending unit requires replacement on certain 2007 Buick Rainier, Chevrolet Trailblazer, GMC Envoy, and Saab 9-7X vehicles. The fuel tank sending unit on these vehicles may have a fractured internal port. A fractured port will not deliver fuel to the engine at the designed pressure. If this were to occur, it could result in an extended start, sluggish acceleration, and/or the illumination of the check engine light. This service procedure should be completed as soon as possible on involved vehicles currently in dealer inventory and customer vehicles that return to the dealer/retailer for any type of service during the New Vehicle Limited Warranty coverage period. Vehicles Involved A list of involved vehicles currently in dealer inventory is attached to the Administrative Message (GM US), Dealer Communication (Canada), or IRIS (Saab U.S.), used to release this bulletin. Customer vehicles that return for service, for any reason, and are still covered under the vehicle's base warranty, and are within the VIN breakpoints shown, should be checked for vehicle eligibility in the appropriate system listed below. Important: Dealers are to confirm vehicle eligibility prior to beginning repairs by using the system(s) below. Not all vehicles within the above breakpoints may be involved. -- GM dealers and Canadian Saab retailers should use GMVIS. -- US Saab dealers should use IRIS On-Line Recall/Campaign Inquiry. Parts Information - GM and Saab Canada Only Parts required to complete this service update are to be obtained from General Motors Service Parts Operations (GMSPO). Please refer to your "involved vehicles listing" before ordering parts. Normal orders should be placed on a DRO = Daily Replenishment Order. In an emergency situation, parts should be ordered on a CSO = Customer Special Order. Parts Information - Saab US Only Technician Safety Information Fuel Pressure: Technician Safety Information Relieving Fuel Pressure Caution Caution: Remove the fuel tank cap and relieve the fuel system pressure before servicing the fuel system in order to reduce the risk of personal injury. After you relieve the fuel system pressure, a small amount of fuel may be released when servicing the fuel lines, the fuel injection pump, or the connections. In order to reduce the risk of personal injury, cover the fuel system components with a shop towel before disconnection. This will catch any fuel that may leak out. Place the towel in an approved container when the disconnection is complete. Page 7766 difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Bosch Connectors (ECM) BOSCH CONNECTORS (ECM) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the assist lever on the top of the connector. Move the assist lever to the forward position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 3745 View of the connector when released from the component. View of another type of Micro 64 connector. Page 3346 Utility/Van Zoning UTILITY/VAN ZONING Page 5822 - Kostel - Molex - Sumitomo - Tyco/AMP - Yazaki Identifying the manufacturer of a connector is often difficult. When trying to determine the manufacturer of a connector, look for specific identifying marks that are unique to that connector supplier. Most of these identify marks are hard to find or see. Check the connector carefully and refer to the information below for pictures and descriptions of connector identification markings. - Most of AFLs connectors have EPC on their connector body. Some of the smaller connectors will not have any markings on them. - In some cases Bosch will actually be printed on the connector. If Bosch does not appear on the connector, look for the Bosch logo. The Bosch logo is a circle with a blunted arrow inside. This logo can appear anywhere on the connector and is often very small. Page 8015 4. Once the front 2 locks are unlocked, lift the front of the dress cover and pull it forward. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the small slot on the TPA and pushing down until the TPA releases. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to angle or rock the J 38125-21 tool when inserting it into the connector or the tool may break. Insert the J 38125-21 (GM P/N 15381651-2) tool into the round canal between the terminals cavities at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to repair Micro 64 connector terminals. The Micro 64 connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-64 (M jaw) was developed to crimp Micro 64 terminals. The J 38125-64 crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. The J 38125-64 crimping tool is also designed to crimp both the wire and the insulation at the same time. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro 64 terminals. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. 1. Cut the wire as close to the damaged terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. Page 7664 7. The illustration above identifies the entry canal where the terminal release tool will be inserted, and the terminal cavity. - Terminal (1) - Entry Canal (2) 8. Insert the J-38125-553 (15315247) tool into the entry canal and pry up on the terminal retainer. The terminal retainer is a small plastic piece on the top of the terminal. The terminal retainer must be held up while the terminal is pulled out of the connector. Page 5821 Connector Anatomy Connector Repairs contains a list of all connector repairs. The connector repairs are listed by the connector manufacturer and then by connector type. If the technician cannot identify the manufacturer of the connector, refer to Identifying Connectors below. Knowing the connector manufacturer will assist in finding the correct connector repair from the following list: - Connector Position Assurance Locks - Terminal Position Assurance Locks - Bosch Connectors (0.64) Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) Bosch Connectors (BSK) Bosch Connectors (ECM) - Delphi Connectors (Micro.64) Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) Delphi Connectors (12-Way) - Tyco/AMP Connectors (CM 42-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) Tyco/AMP Connectors (025 Cap) Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) - Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) - Repairing Connector Terminals IDENTIFYING CONNECTORS Knowing the connector manufacturer is helpful when trying to locating the correct connector repair procedure. There are many different connector designs used on GM vehicles and it is sometimes difficult to identify the connector manufacturer. The information in this document should help with the identification of connector manufactures. The following connector manufacturers make most of the connectors found in GM vehicles: AFL/EPC (Alcoa Fujikura Ltd./Engineered Plastics Components) - Bosch - Delphi - FCI (Framatome Connectors International) - JAE (Japan Aviation Electronics) - JST (Japan Solderless Terminals) Page 460 Page 1329 IMPORTANT: Ensure that the dress cover and connector body are both in the released position before reassembling. Failure to do so may cause damage to the connector and component. Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (0.64) BOSCH CONNECTORS (0.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While pressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock until the lever is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Pull the rubber boot that covers the wires back to expose the end of the connector dress cover. 4. Place the connector locking lever in the center of the connector. 5. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs that are on the wire end of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover and connector body and pry up. Page 6097 The first connector design of the Micro-Pack 100W (1) has a white connector interface that holds the terminals. The second design of the Micro-Pack 100W (2) has a gray interface to hold the terminals. Also, the first design has terminal cavities that are further apart (3 mm centerline) and offset from the other row of terminal cavities in the connector. The second design has terminals cavities that are closer together (2.54 mm centerline) and aligned vertically. One other way to identify the second design is the thin strip of material that runs along the outside of the cavities. IMPORTANT: There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W terminals which are very similar. Ensure that you have the correct terminal before crimping the new terminal to the wire. The first design connector uses the longer terminal (1) that has a raised area in front of the recess in the terminal. The second design connector uses the shorter terminal without the raised area. Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro-Pack 100W connectors. Some Micro-Pack 100W connector disassembly procedures will vary. Use this procedure as a guide. 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 7529 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 2235 2. Locate the nose piece locking tabs that are positioned on the side of the connector nose piece. The connector nose piece acts as a terminal positive assurance (TPA) and may be referred to as such. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to push in one of the locking tabs while gently pulling on the same side of the nose piece. 4. Repeat the procedure for the other locking tab and remove the nose piece. 5. Remove the wire dress cover. The following is a general procedure for wire dress cover removal. Use this procedure as a guide, some dress cover removal procedures may vary. 6. Use fingers to squeeze the 2 locking legs of the cover. Page 3064 3. Radiator outlet hose (lower hose) to engine (3). (Shown as viewed from below.) 4. Radiator outlet hose (lower hose) to radiator (4). (Shown as viewed from below.) 5. Heater inlet hose to engine (5). Page 8718 2. Use a small flat-bladed tool to release the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting the tool in the small recess on the side of the connector and pushing up until the TPA releases from the connector body. The TPA should raise just slightly. Do not try to remove the TPA. IMPORTANT: The TPA on this connector cannot be removed unless the terminals are removed first. The TPA will come out of the connector body, but only slightly. When the TPA is slightly raised the terminals can be removed. Using excessive force to remove the TPA with the terminals still in the connector will damage the connector. 3. Repeat the process for the other side of the connector. 4. Ensure that the TPA is in the proper position to remove the terminals. Page 6964 5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape. Seat Belt Schematic Icons Seat Belt Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons Page 1572 - A control module from another vehicle is installed. - Revised software/calibration files have been released for this vehicle. - IMPORTANT: DO NOT re-program the control module with the SAME software/calibration files that are already present in the control module. This is not an effective repair for any type of concern. Verify that the control module contains the correct software/calibration. If incorrect programming is found, reprogram the control module with the most current software/calibration. Refer to Control Module References for replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Testing for Short to Ground TESTING FOR SHORT TO GROUND NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 4. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit. With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is a short to ground in the circuit. Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2. Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). - When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. - If the DMM does not display voltage 4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is shorted. Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A DIGITAL MULTIMETER NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the powertrain control module (PCM), should only be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200 Digital Multimeter (DMM). The J 39200 instruction manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminage even though voltage is present. The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity. IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading. Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the measurement. Restraints - Passenger Presence System Information Seat Occupant Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Restraints - Passenger Presence System Information INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 06-08-50-009F Date: December 23, 2010 Subject: Information on Passenger Presence Sensing System (PPS or PSS) Concerns With Custom Upholstery, Accessory Seat Heaters or Other Comfort Enhancing Devices Models: 2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks Equipped with Passenger Presence Sensing System Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 06-08-50-009E (Section 08 - Body and Accessories). Concerns About Safety and Alterations to the Front Passenger Seat Important ON A GM VEHICLE EQUIPPED WITH A PASSENGER SENSING SYSTEM, USE THE SEAT COVERS AND OTHER SEAT-RELATED EQUIPMENT AS RELEASED BY GM FOR THAT VEHICLE. DO NOT ALTER THE SEAT COVERS OR SEAT-RELATED EQUIPMENT. ANY ALTERATIONS TO SEAT COVERS OR GM ACCESSORIES DEFEATS THE INTENDED DESIGN OF THE SYSTEM. GM WILL NOT BE LIABLE FOR ANY PROBLEMS CAUSED BY USE OF SUCH IMPROPER SEAT ALTERATIONS, INCLUDING ANY WARRANTY REPAIRS INCURRED. The front passenger seat in many GM vehicles is equipped with a passenger sensing system that will turn off the right front passenger's frontal airbag under certain conditions, such as when an infant or child seat is present. In some vehicles, the passenger sensing system will also turn off the right front passenger's seat mounted side impact airbag. For the system to function properly, sensors are used in the seat to detect the presence of a properly-seated occupant. The passenger sensing system may not operate properly if the original seat trim is replaced (1) by non-GM covers, upholstery or trim, or (2) by GM covers, upholstery or trim designed for a different vehicle or (3) by GM covers, upholstery or trim that has been altered by a trim shop, or (4) if any object, such as an aftermarket seat heater or a comfort enhancing pad or device is installed under the seat fabric or between the occupant and the seat fabric. Aftermarket Seat Heaters, Custom Upholstery, and Comfort Enhancing Pads or Devices Important ON A GM VEHICLE EQUIPPED WITH A PASSENGER SENSING SYSTEM, USE ONLY SEAT COVERS AND OTHER SEAT-RELATED EQUIPMENT RELEASED AS GM ACCESSORIES FOR THAT VEHICLE. DO NOT USE ANY OTHER TYPE OF SEAT COVERS OR SEAT-RELATED EQUIPMENT, OR GM ACCESSORIES RELEASED FOR OTHER VEHICLE APPLICATIONS. GM WILL NOT BE LIABLE FOR ANY PROBLEMS CAUSED BY USE OF SUCH IMPROPER SEAT ACCESSORIES, INCLUDING ANY WARRANTY REPAIRS MADE NECESSARY BY SUCH USE. Many types of aftermarket accessories are available to customers, upfitting shops, and dealers. Some of these devices sit on top of, or are Velcro(R) strapped to the seat while others such as seat heaters are installed under the seat fabric. Additionally, seat covers made of leather or other materials may have different padding thickness installed that could prevent the Passenger Sensing System from functioning properly. Never alter the vehicle seats. Never add pads or other devices to the seat cushion, as this may interfere with the operation of the Passenger Sensing System and either prevent proper deployment of the passenger airbag or prevent proper suppression of the passenger air bag. Disclaimer Page 6008 Release the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the blue locking tabs on both ends of the connector. Gently slide the TPA up to the released position on both ends. 6. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-13A (GM P/N 12031876-1) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. Page 3771 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry one side of the nose piece up to the pre-stage position. When the nose piece is in the pre-staged position, the nose piece will be raised above the connector body the length of the step in the nose piece. 7. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry the other side of the piece to the pre-stage position. If the nose piece is higher than the first step in the nose piece, gently push down on the nose piece until it meets with resistance from the connector body, you should feel the nose piece click into position. Page 6240 MOLEX CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. 2. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. Page 6029 US English/Metric Conversion US English/Metric Conversion Page 5111 Note The dealer will receive an e-mail reply after the calibrations have been validated. The e-mail reply will advise the dealer if the calibrations are OEM. 28. Allow two hours for the PQC to verify the calibrations and set up the case details. ‹› If the PQC determines that the calibrations ARE aftermarket calibrations, DO NOT contact GM Technical Assistance to discuss warranty concerns on the aftermarket calibrations. ALL questions and concerns about warranty should be directed to the dealers Fixed Operations Manager (FOM), (Warranty Manager (WM) in Canada). 29. You may call the PQC two hours after submitting the e-mail for authorization to replace the assembly. This will provide them time to receive, review and set up a case on the request. Please be prepared to provide all the usual documentation that is normally required when requesting an assembly authorization from the PQC. Warranty Information - The Dealership Service Management must be involved in any situation that would justify the use of labor operation Z1111. - Notify the Fixed Operations Manager (FOM) (Warranty Manager (WM) in Canada) of the situation. - All claims will have to be routed to the FOM (WM in Canada) for approval. - Please refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 09-00-89-016, Labor Operation Z1111 - Suspected Tampering or Vehicle Modifications for important information. For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table above. Disclaimer Page 2333 5. Insert the J 38125-557 (GM P/N 12122378) into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 6. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Connector Position Assurance Locks CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of the connector. CPAs are used in various connectors throughout the vehicle. CPAs are also used in all SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals, of the connector. Connector Repairs CONNECTOR REPAIRS Page 8071 11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the solder equipment. 12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. 13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to cover the first piece of tape. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE SLEEVES TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit IMPORTANT: Use only dura seal splice sleeves. Other splice sleeves may not protect the splice from moisture or provide a good electrical connection. Use duraseal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. Use duraseal splice sleeves where there is special requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire using duraseal splice sleeves. Engine/Transmission - Aftermarket Calibrations Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine/Transmission - Aftermarket Calibrations INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 09-06-04-026B Date: April 07, 2010 Subject: Identifying Non-GM (Aftermarket) Engine and Transmission Calibrations for V8 Gas Engines Using Tech 2(R) or Global Diagnostic System (GDS) Models: 2006-2010 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Excluding Saab 9-7X) 2006-2009 HUMMER H2 2006-2010 HUMMER H3 Equipped with V8 Gas Powered Engines Only Attention: This bulletin applies to V8 gas powered engines ONLY. For Duramax(TM) diesel powered engines, refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 08-06-04-006G. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2010 model year and information about retrieving calibrations on a Global A vehicle. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 09-06-04-026A (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). General Motors is identifying an increasing number of engine, transmission and catalytic converter part failures that are the result of non-GM (aftermarket) engine and transmission control calibrations being used. When alteration to the GM-released engine or transmission control calibrations occurs, it subjects powertrain and driveline components (engine, transmission, transfer case, driveshaft and rear axle) to stresses that were not tested by General Motors. It is because of these unknown stresses, and the potential to alter reliability, durability and emissions performance, that GM has adopted a policy that prevents any UNAUTHORIZED dealer warranty claim submissions to any remaining warranty coverage, to the powertrain and driveline components whenever the presence of a non-GM (aftermarket) calibration is confirmed - even if the non-GM control module calibration is subsequently removed. Warranty coverage is based on the equipment and calibrations that were released on the vehicle at time of sale, or subsequently updated by GM. That's because GM testing and validation matches the calibration to a host of criteria that is essential to assure reliability, durability and emissions performance over the life of the warranty coverage and beyond. Stresses resulting from calibrations different from those tested and released by GM can damage or weaken components, leading to poor performance and or shortened life. Additionally, non-GM (aftermarket) issued engine control modifications often do not meet the same emissions performance standards as GM issued calibrations. Depending on state statutes, individuals who install engine control module calibrations that put the vehicle outside the parameters of emissions certification standards may be subject to fines and/or penalties. This bulletin outlines a procedure to identify the presence of non-GM (aftermarket) calibrations. GM recommends performing this check whenever a hard part failure is seen on internal engine or transmission components, or before an engine assembly or transmission assembly is being replaced under warranty. It is also recommended that the engine calibration verification procedure be performed whenever diagnostics indicate that catalytic converter replacement is indicated. The PQC has a process to confirm the ECM/PCM calibration is GM issued. The PQC will require a picture of the engine calibration verification screen, as outlined in this bulletin, before authorizing any V8 gas powered engine replacement. If a non-GM calibration is found and verification has taken place through GM, the remaining powertrain and driveline warranty will be blocked and notated in GMVIS and the dealership will be notified. This block prevents any UNAUTHORIZED warranty claim submission. 1. Connect the Tech 2(R) to the vehicle. 2. Go to: Diagnostics and build the vehicle. 3. Select: Powertrain. 4. Select: Engine. 5. *Select: Engine Control Module or PCM. 6. *Select: Module ID Information or I/M Information System if the Module ID Information selection is not available. 7. *If "I/M information System" was selected, it may be necessary to select "Vehicle Information" in order to display the calibration information. ‹› If the CVN information is displayed as "N/A", it will be necessary to contact the TCSC to obtain the CVN information. Locations Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Locations Park Neutral Position (PNP) Switch 1 - Automatic Transmission 4L60-E/4L65-E/4L70 2 - Park/Neutral Position (PNP) Switch Page 1844 to analyze the data during the time a vehicle condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a trigger point that you have determined. Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2 snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a first-in, first-out basis. If a third snapshot is taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost. Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types: Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice - Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200 frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not lost if the Scan Tool is powered down. The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis. The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected values by plotting 3 parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful, especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC. Testing for a Short to Voltage TESTING FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4. Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt, there is a short to voltage in the circuit. Testing for Continuity TESTING FOR CONTINUITY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6. Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit. 7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity. With a Test Lamp IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits. 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6. If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity. Testing for Electrical Intermittents TESTING FOR ELECTRICAL INTERMITTENTS Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment. - Testing for Short to Ground - Testing for Continuity - Testing for a Short to Voltage Page 7449 Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Diagrams Engine Controls Connector End Views Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor Page 5662 Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Page 277 Front Passenger Door Module (FPDM) C2 Page 2079 Page 252 View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. 4. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers CIRCUIT PROTECTION - CIRCUIT BREAKERS A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types of circuit Page 937 Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models) Important Select the appropriate Labor Operation for the repair that is performed. For vehicles repaired under warranty, use: Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 8028 REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. The release tab is located on the top of the wiredress cover. View of connector in released position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Page 5757 Crankshaft Position Sensor: Connector Views Engine Controls Connector End Views Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor Page 3454 Fuse Block - Rear C3 (Pin E4 To F6) Page 9036 Depress the locks that are located on both sides of the wiredress cover and pull the lever over and past the locks. View of the connector when released from the component. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the front of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool push down on one of the locking tabs and pull the cover up until the dress cover releases. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. Page 3268 2. Locate the nose piece locking tabs that are positioned on the side of the connector nose piece. The connector nose piece acts as a terminal positive assurance (TPA) and may be referred to as such. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to push in one of the locking tabs while gently pulling on the same side of the nose piece. 4. Repeat the procedure for the other locking tab and remove the nose piece. 5. Remove the wire dress cover. The following is a general procedure for wire dress cover removal. Use this procedure as a guide, some dress cover removal procedures may vary. 6. Use fingers to squeeze the 2 locking legs of the cover. OnStar(R) - Availability for Hearing Impaired Communications Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Availability for Hearing Impaired INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 06-08-46-005B Date: February 11, 2010 Subject: Availability of OnStar(R) for Hearing Impaired Models: 2007-2010 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Including Saturn and Saab) Except 2007 Cadillac CTS Except 2007-2008 HUMMER H2, H2 SUT Except 2007 Pontiac Montana SV6 Except 2007-2010 Pontiac Vibe Except 2007 Saturn ION, VUE Except 2008 Saturn Astra Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add a Note regarding 2009 Bluetooth(R)-equipped vehicles, additional models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 06-08-46-005A (Section 08 - Body and Accessories). Important This service bulletin is not applicable to 'GM of Canada' dealers and retailers. Note On 2009 and newer model year vehicles equipped with the Bluetooth(R) feature (option code UPF), when up-fitted with TTY capabilities, the Bluetooth(R) feature will be disabled. OnStar with Text Telephone Capability (TTY) General Motors is pleased to announce that the safety and security of OnStar is now available to our deaf, hard of hearing and speech impaired customers. The current vehicles listed above, as well as forthcoming vehicles equipped with OnStar hardware version 7.0 or higher, have the ability to utilize texting telephones. Vehicle specific TTY capability can be determined by utilizing the VIN lookup Tool. Additional information may be found by referring to www.onstar.com/tty. TTY equipment allows people who are deaf, hard of hearing or speech impaired, in-vehicle access to 911 and basic OnStar(R) services by pressing the OnStar(R) blue button or red emergency button. The keypad provides a means to communicate by allowing customers to type messages back and forth, with an OnStar(R) advisor or other party when using the OnStar(R) Hands-Free Calling feature. A TTY is required at both ends of the conversation in order to communicate. OnStar(R) Turn by Turn Navigation and Virtual Advisor are not available with the addition of TTY. The Reimbursement Program This equipment will be made available to eligible customers through GM Mobility and OnStar(R). Under this program, the customer must complete a GM Mobility application form. To take advantage of the program, vehicles must be adapted at the time of delivery for purchase / lease and a dealer claim ($1,000 Maximum per GM Mobility guidelines) with the application form submitted to GM Mobility. Saab dealers must fax documents. GM Dealers will receive electronic reimbursement directly from GM Mobility. Saab dealers will receive a check directly from OnStar(R). Additional questions or concerns should be directed to the OnStar Dealer Center. How to Order To order the dealer installed kit, contact AutoCraft Electronics or via the web at www.autocraft.com. The kit consists of an OnStar Interface Module, a Dial Pad (for making calls), OTIM wiring harness, the TTY device, installation/Tech 2(R) programming instructions and owner's guide. Warranty Information The Ultra-Tec Compact C TTY device is manufactured by an independent manufacturer and is covered by the manufacturer's warranty. It is not covered under the GM New Vehicle Limited Warranty. All other parts (OTIM, dial pad and OTIM wiring harness) are covered by the standard GM new vehicle parts and labor warranty. Replacement parts are available through AutoCraft Electronics. Contact AutoCraft Electronics or via the web. Warranty claims for the OTIM, dial pad and OTIM wiring harness should be submitted through normal warranty procedures using a sublet warranty claim with GM Labor Operation R5140. Page 8365 Page 6726 5. While pushing the terminal forward, insert the J 38125-24 in the release cavity above the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (43-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Page 3327 Page 3128 Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 1. Install the drain plug. Tighten the drain plug to 33 N.m (24 lb ft). Important: With a complete drain and refill, subsutiute 4 oz (118 ml) of limited-slip axle lubricant additive. 2. Fill the rear drive axle. ^ Use the proper fluid, refer to Sealers, Adhesives, and Lubricants. ^ For the proper capacity, refer to Approximate Fluid Capacities. 3. Install the fill plug. Tighten the fill plug to 33 N.m (24 lb ft). Page 5828 View of the connector when released from the component. View of another type of Micro 64 connector. Page 435 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Start in the middle and gradually move the heat barrel to the open ends of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Heated Oxygen Sensor Wiring Repairs HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being obstructed. If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. - Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks, etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire. - Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance. - To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector. Engine - MIL ON P0116/P1400 Set In Very Cold Temps Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - MIL ON P0116/P1400 Set In Very Cold Temps TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 10-06-04-008A Date: January 24, 2011 Subject: Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) Illuminated at Very Cold Ambient Temperatures When Using Engine Coolant Heater, DTC P0116 and/or P1400 Set (Relocate Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor and Engine Coolant Heater Cord) Models: 2006-2007 Buick Rainier 2009 Buick LaCrosse Super, Allure Super (Canada Only) 2006-2010 Cadillac Escalade 2006-2007 Chevrolet Monte Carlo 2006-2009 Chevrolet Impala SS, TrailBlazer 2006-2010 Chevrolet Avalanche, Express, Silverado Tahoe 2006-2009 GMC Envoy 2006-2010 GMC Savana, Sierra, Yukon 2006-2008 Pontiac Grand Prix 2006-2009 Saab 9-7X Equipped with V8 Engine RPO LC9, LH6, LH8, LH9, L76, LS2, LS4, LFA, LZ1, L92, L94, L9H or L20, L96, LMF, LMG, LY2, LY5, LY6 Please Refer to GMVIS Attention: To properly correct this condition, you must follow both of the procedures to relocate the ECT sensor and the engine coolant heater cord. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add cast iron block engine RPOs and to update the Warranty Information coverage period. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 10-06-04-008 (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). Condition Some customers may comment that the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) illuminates after starting the vehicle when they were using the engine coolant heater in very cold ambient temperatures. This usually occurs in a range of -23 to -40°C (-10 to -40°F) or colder. The technician may observe on a scan tool DTC P0116 and/or P1400 set as Current or in History. Cause This condition may be caused by the engine control module (ECM) determining that the ignition OFF time requirement has been met at start-up and interpreting the temperature difference between the engine coolant temperature (ECT) sensor and the intake air temperature (IAT) sensor as being outside of a calibrated range. Correction Important DO NOT replace the ECM for this condition. Relocating the ECT Sensor 1. Turn ON the ignition with the engine OFF. 2. Perform the diagnostic system check - vehicle. Refer to Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle in SI. ‹› If DTC P0116 and/or P1400 are set and the customer WAS using the engine coolant heater, proceed to Step 3. ‹› If DTC P0116 and/or P1400 are set and the customer WAS NOT using the engine coolant heater, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle in SI. 3. Turn OFF the ignition. Warning To avoid being burned, do not remove the radiator cap or surge tank cap while the engine is hot. The cooling system will release scalding fluid and steam Page 3301 3. Ensure that the terminal release tang access panel is in the correct location to access the terminals. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) into the terminal release tang access slot located behind the access panel of the connector and press down on the terminal while carefully pulling the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Tyco/AMP Connectors (0.25 Cap) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (025 CAP) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component by pressing down on the connector position assurance (CPA). Page 5253 Engine Control Module (ECM) C3 (Pin 60 To 73) Page 7654 View of typical connector. View of connector in released position. 1. Locate the assist lever at the back of the connector. Move the assist lever to the rear position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the dress cover. Page 3281 2. Locate the two indents of the terminal position assurance (TPA) located on the bottom of the connector body. Page 5948 Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. For connectors with a bolt in the dress cover, turn the bolt counterclockwise to remove the connector from the component. 2. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. Page 6103 The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors. 1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position. 4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool J 38125-10A (GM P/N 12014012-1) into the front (mating end) of the connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal through the back of the connector (2). IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector. 6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. 7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily. 10. Perform system check. Delphi Connectors (12 Way) DELPHI CONNECTORS (12-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. Page 3557 3. Insert the sensor in the wheel hole with the air passage facing away from the wheel. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 4. Install the sensor nut and position the sensor body parallel to the inside wheel surface while torquing. Tighten the sensor nut to 7 N.m (62 lb in). Important: Before installing the tire on the wheel, note the following items to avoid tire pressure sensor damage upon tire mounting: ^ Position the mounting/dismounting head 180 degrees from the valve stem. ^ Position the bead transition area 45 degrees counterclockwise of the valve stem. ^ Using the tire machine, rotate the tire/wheel assembly clockwise when transferring the tire bead to the inside of the wheel rim. ^ Repeat items for outer bead. Install the tire on the wheel. Refer to Tire Mounting and Dismounting . ^ Install the tire/wheel assembly on the vehicle. Refer to Tire and Wheel Removal and Installation. ^ Lower the vehicle. Page 2194 A/T - Key Will Not Release From Ignition Lock Cylinder Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Customer Interest A/T - Key Will Not Release From Ignition Lock Cylinder Bulletin No.: 05-07-30-021B Date: October 04, 2007 TECHNICAL Subject: Ignition Key Will Not Remove From Ignition Lock Cylinder (Reposition Shifter Boot) Models: 2004-2007 Buick Rainier 2002-2008 Chevrolet TrailBlazer Models 2002-2008 GMC Envoy Models 2003-2004 Oldsmobile Bravada Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to include the 2008 model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 05-07-30-021A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle). Condition Some customers may comment that they are unable to remove the ignition key from the ignition cylinder. Cause The shifter boot may be caught/trapped in the shifter assembly mechanism. Correction Inspect the shifter boot for being caught/trapped in the shifter assembly. If the shifter boot is NOT caught/trapped in the shift assembly, refer to Ignition Key Cannot Be Removed from the Ignition Lock Cylinder in SI. If the shifter boot IS caught/trapped in the shifter assembly, continue with the next step. DO NOT replace the complete shifter assembly for this condition. ONLY replace the shifter boot/handle if damaged by shifter assembly. Reposition the shifter boot so that it is not caught/trapped in the shifter assembly. Warranty Information Specifications Ignition Cable: Specifications Spark Plug Wire Resistance................................................................................................................. ...........................................................397-1,337 ohms Page 7510 TERMINAL REMOVAL Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors. 1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA) device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1). 3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 4. Gently pull the cable and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector. 5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal, refer to Terminal Repair. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3. Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector. REINSTALLING TERMINAL 1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly, refer to Wiring Repairs. 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3. Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) DELPHI CONNECTORS (WEATHER PACK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 6986 Body Control Module (BCM) C3 Page 5136 Note The dealer will receive an e-mail reply after the calibrations have been validated. The e-mail reply will advise the dealer if the calibrations are OEM. 28. Allow two hours for the PQC to verify the calibrations and set up the case details. ‹› If the PQC determines that the calibrations ARE aftermarket calibrations, DO NOT contact GM Technical Assistance to discuss warranty concerns on the aftermarket calibrations. ALL questions and concerns about warranty should be directed to the dealers Fixed Operations Manager (FOM), (Warranty Manager (WM) in Canada). 29. You may call the PQC two hours after submitting the e-mail for authorization to replace the assembly. This will provide them time to receive, review and set up a case on the request. Please be prepared to provide all the usual documentation that is normally required when requesting an assembly authorization from the PQC. Warranty Information - The Dealership Service Management must be involved in any situation that would justify the use of labor operation Z1111. - Notify the Fixed Operations Manager (FOM) (Warranty Manager (WM) in Canada) of the situation. - All claims will have to be routed to the FOM (WM in Canada) for approval. - Please refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 09-00-89-016, Labor Operation Z1111 - Suspected Tampering or Vehicle Modifications for important information. For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table above. Disclaimer Page 4536 9. The illustration shows a cutaway view of the connector to aid the technician in releasing the terminal retainer. 10. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Terminal Position Assurance Locks TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Tyco/Amp Connectors (CM 42-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (CM 42-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the connector body and pull the CPA out. The CPA is on the wire harness side of connector. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 1785 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the DuraSeal splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of a connector. CPAs are used in all SIR System connectors and also in some connectors of other systems. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals of a connection. TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE CLIPS IMPORTANT: When making a splice in an area that may be exposed to moisture use a crimp and seal splice sleeve instead of a Splice Clip. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. Page 789 8. Install the ECM/TCM cover. 9. Ensure the ECM/TCM cover retainers (1) are fully engaged to the ECM/TCM bracket. 10. Connect the cooling fan electrical connector. 11. Connect the negative battery cable. 12. If the ECM was replaced the replacement ECM must be programmed. Refer to Control Module References. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Page 2880 1. Install the air cleaner outlet duct. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Install the air cleaner outlet duct bolt. Tighten the bolt to 10 N.m (89 lb in). 3. Tighten the clamps at the following: * MAF/IAT sensor * Throttle body Tighten the clamps to 7 N.m (62 lb in). 4. Connect the PCV fresh air tube (2) to the air cleaner resonator outlet duct (1). Page 6406 Utility/Van Zoning UTILITY/VAN ZONING Page 3276 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the TPA. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the nose piece. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. Page 2572 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (BSK) BOSCH CONNECTORS (BSK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 3. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 4. Insert the J 38125-561 tool into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 5. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is Page 8827 4. Slide the dress cover forward and off of the connector. 5. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front and rear of the connector. Page 2401 6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias. Reference the appropriate service manual wiring schematic to obtain the correct diode installation position. 7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for the soldering equipment. 8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed. 9. IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode attachment points with tape. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape. Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable SPLICING TWISTED OR SHIELDED CABLE Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable. 1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splice is made. 3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire. Staggering the splices by 65 mm (2.5 in) is recommended. 4. IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical contact with the drain wire. Re-assemble the cable. Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape. - Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1). - Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire. - Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape. Page 8901 Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. For connectors with a bolt in the dress cover, turn the bolt counterclockwise to remove the connector from the component. 2. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. Page 1984 6. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs located on the opposite side of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover at the connector end and pry up. 7. Remove the dress cover. 8. Cut the tie wrap on the wire bundle. 9. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting a small flat-bladed tool into the small slot in the end of the slider and pushing on the TPA until it comes out of the connector. When the TPA exits the opposite side of the connector, gasp the TPA and pull it completely out of the connector. 10. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 1605 Release the lower wiredress cover locking tab. Release the upper wiredress cover locking tab. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. Page 3954 Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair Fuel Pressure Gage Installation and Removal Fuel Pressure Gage Installation and Removal Tools Required CH-48027 Digital Pressure Gage Installation Procedure Caution: Refer to Gasoline/Gasoline Vapors Caution. Caution: Remove the fuel tank cap and relieve the fuel system pressure before servicing the fuel system in order to reduce the risk of personal injury. After you relieve the fuel system pressure, a small amount of fuel may be released when servicing the fuel lines, the fuel injection pump, or the connections. In order to reduce the risk of personal injury, cover the fuel system components with a shop towel before disconnection. This will catch any fuel that may leak out. Place the towel in an approved container when the disconnection is complete. 1. Relieve the fuel system pressure. Refer to Fuel Pressure Relief. 2. Connect the CH-48027-1 (1) to the CH-48027-2 (2). 3. Remove the shop towel from around the fuel rail service port, and place in an approved gasoline container. 4. Perform any tests and/or diagnostics as needed. For the proper usage of the CH-48027 , refer to the manufacture's directions. Removal Procedure Page 3746 Depress the locks that are located on both sides of the wiredress cover and pull the lever over and past the locks. View of the connector when released from the component. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the front of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool push down on one of the locking tabs and pull the cover up until the dress cover releases. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. Page 736 8. Insert the J 38125-213 into the small terminal release hole on the nose piece and gently pull on the back of the wire. 9. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Repairing Connector Terminals REPAIRING CONNECTOR TERMINALS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following: Push to Seat terminals - Pull to Seat terminals Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your terminal repair. The J-38125 contains further information. 1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.For cable seal terminals, remove the seal. 2. Apply the correct cable seal per gage size of the wire, if used.Slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation removal. 3. Remove the insulation. 4. For sealed terminals only, align the seal with the end of the cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal.For sealed terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal. 6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.For sealed terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable. 8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals excepting Micro-Pack 100.64 size. Soldering Micro-Pack 100 World terminals may damage the terminal. Sumitomo Connectors SUMITOMO CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 2124 pulling it through. This will prevent damage to the internal seals of the connector. Once the terminal is pushed out of the connector, cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible and pull the wire through the connector. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE The Micro-Pack 100W connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool was developed to crimp Micro-Pack 100W terminals. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 2. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert the terminal into the crimp tool until the core wings are flush with the anvil on the crimp tool. Be sure that the wings are pointed toward the crimp tool former and release the spring locator. The locator will hold the terminal in place. Inspect the alignment of the terminal wings with the crimp tool former. If the terminal wings are wider than the crimp tool former, remove the terminal and bend the terminal wings in slightly. 5. Place stripped wire into terminal. 6. Crimp the new terminal to the wire. If a jam occurs, press the emergency release to open applicator. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire perform the following procedure in order to replace Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. Page 8886 Utility/Van Zoning UTILITY/VAN ZONING Page 942 For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 4345 6. Heater outlet hose to engine (6). 7. Heater inlet hose to front of dash (7). 8. Heater outlet hose to front of dash (8). Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models) Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models) Page 2419 Page 2631 6. Gently pry the plastic terminal retainer down and carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (16-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, pull the two connector halves apart. Technician Safety Information Fuel Pressure: Technician Safety Information Relieving Fuel Pressure Caution Caution: Remove the fuel tank cap and relieve the fuel system pressure before servicing the fuel system in order to reduce the risk of personal injury. After you relieve the fuel system pressure, a small amount of fuel may be released when servicing the fuel lines, the fuel injection pump, or the connections. In order to reduce the risk of personal injury, cover the fuel system components with a shop towel before disconnection. This will catch any fuel that may leak out. Place the towel in an approved container when the disconnection is complete. Page 6183 All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system. Locations Oxygen Sensor: Locations Engine Controls Component Views Below Rear of the Engine 1 - Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Bank 2 Sensor 2 2 - Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Bank 2 Sensor 1 3 - Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Bank 1 Sensor 2 4 - Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Bank 1 Sensor 1 Page 5339 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the rear TPA from the connector. 7. IMPORTANT: The front TPA cannot be removed from the connector. Only move it to the release point. Use a small flat-blade tool to move the front TPA to the release position. 8. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 9. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Molex Connectors Page 462 All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system. Page 4779 MEASURING FREQUENCY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal. IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM to autorange to an appropriate range. 1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency measured. Measuring Voltage MEASURING VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit. 1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods: - Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. - Turn ON the engine. - Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls. - Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested. 3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The DMM displays the voltage measured at that point. Measuring Voltage Drop MEASURING VOLTAGE DROP NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points. Probing Electrical Connectors PROBING ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS Page 8032 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully raise the TPA on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA cannot be removed from the connector while there are terminals present in the connector body. View of the TPA when removed from the connector body. 4. Use the J 38125-12A tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the left side of the terminal release cavity as shown in the graphic. Use the tool to move the terminal release to the right with a gentle prying motion. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 4709 Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Install the ECT sensor. Tighten the sensor to 20 N.m (15 lb ft). 3. Connect the ECT sensor electrical connector (1). 4. Refill the engine coolant. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System (LL8) Draining and Filling Cooling System (LH6, LS2). Page 1697 Knock Sensor: Diagnostic Aids Arrows and Symbols Arrows and Symbols This Service Data uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations. Arrows and Symbols 1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow Basic Knowledge Required GENERAL ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures contained in the service manual. You should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current (amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram, as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. Decimal and Metric Equivalents Decimal and Metric Equivalents Page 7227 Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size. REPAIRING A FUSIBLE LINK IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient overload protection. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. Flat Wire Repairs FLAT WIRE REPAIRS NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced. GMLAN Wiring Repairs GMLAN WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The GM Local Area Network (GMLAN) System requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working on GMLAN connectors and terminals. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items in order to repair the GMLAN wiring: Dura Seal splice sleeves - A wire stripping tool - J 38125-8 Crimping Tool (GM P/N 12085115) - J 38125-5 Ultra Torch Special Tool (GM P/N 12085116) The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. - A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors GMLAN REPAIRS IMPORTANT: When making a repair to any GMLAN network, the original wire length after the repair must be the same length as before the repair. If the network is a twisted pair, the twist must be maintained after the repair is completed. GMLAN has 2 types of networks, low speed and high speed. Low speed GMLAN has a single wire and works at slow speeds. High speed GMLAN has 2 wires in a twisted pair and works at higher speeds. For more information on GMLAN, refer to Data Link Communications Description and Operation. GMLAN CONNECTOR TERMINAL REPAIR IMPORTANT: A service terminal can be used to replace damaged connector terminals for both high speed and low speed GMLAN systems. When making a connector terminal repair on a GMLAN high speed system with twisted pair wires, do not untwist the wires more than necessary to make the repair. The terminals in the GMLAN system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are available in the J-38125. If the individual terminals are damaged on any GMLAN connection, use the appropriate connector repair procedure in order to repair the terminal. GMLAN WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 470 Refer to the following table as a guide in selecting the correct test adapter for front probing connectors: Backprobe IMPORTANT: Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures. - Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector. - Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large of a test probe. - After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected, test for proper terminal contact. Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the connector. Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure SCAN TOOL SNAPSHOT PROCEDURE Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used Page 1470 4. Use a small flat-blade tool to slide the terminal position assurance (TPA) up one notch on both ends of the connector. The TPA is located underneath the wire dress cover. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 4758 1. Install the inlet hose to the radiator. 2. Using J 38185 reposition the radiator inlet hose clamp to the radiator. 3. Install the inlet hose to the engine. 4. Using J 38185 reposition the radiator inlet hose clamp to the engine. 5. Install the air intake resonator. Refer to Air Cleaner Resonator Outlet Duct Replacement for the 5.3L engine or Air Cleaner Resonator Outlet Duct Replacement for the 6.0L engine. 6. Fill the cooling system. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System (LL8) Draining and Filling Cooling System (LH6, LS2). Page 6916 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the TPA. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the nose piece. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. Page 370 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (BSK) BOSCH CONNECTORS (BSK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 3. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 4. Insert the J 38125-561 tool into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 5. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is Page 1778 If a wire is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm, etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except coaxial. - Do not use the DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent American wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 256 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Start in the middle and gradually move the heat barrel to the open ends of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Heated Oxygen Sensor Wiring Repairs HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being obstructed. If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. - Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks, etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire. - Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance. - To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector. Page 7850 Oxygen Sensor: Service Precautions Silicon Contamination of Heated Oxygen Sensors Notice Silicon Contamination of Heated Oxygen Sensors Notice Notice: Contamination of the oxygen sensor can result from the use of an inappropriate RTV sealant (not oxygen sensor safe) or excessive engine coolant or oil consumption. Remove the HO2S and visually inspect the portion of the sensor exposed to the exhaust stream in order to check for contamination. If contaminated, the portion of the sensor exposed to the exhaust stream will have a white powdery coating. Silicon contamination causes a high but false HO2S signal voltage (rich exhaust indication). The control module will then reduce the amount of fuel delivered to the engine, causing a severe driveability problem. Eliminate the source of contamination before replacing the oxygen sensor. Page 3379 View of a typical Micro 64 connector. Depress the lock and pull the lever over and past the lock. Page 5712 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Kostal Connectors KOSTAL CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 4026 10. Raise the engine 2 1/4 inches measuring from the bottom of the oil pan to the front edge of the transmission support crossmember. 11. Shift the engine towards the left side of the frame. 12. Remove the engine mount frame bracket from the frame. Page 7470 Page 744 2. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 2673 9. Position the headlamp wire harness (1) to the retaining clip. 10. Install and secure the headlamp wire harness in the retaining clip (1). 11. Install the grille. 12. Enable the SIR system. Refer to SIR Disabling and Enabling. Page 8849 6. Gently pry the plastic terminal retainer down and carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (16-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, pull the two connector halves apart. Page 7209 5. Once the nose piece retainers are relaxed, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should raise slightly. 6. On the opposite side of the nose piece, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should release completely. If the nose piece does not come off, repeat the procedure on the opposite side. Page 2503 If a wire is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm, etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except coaxial. - Do not use the DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent American wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 3767 4. Slide the dress cover forward and off of the connector. 5. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front and rear of the connector. Page 2083 Utility/Van Zoning UTILITY/VAN ZONING Page 8403 View of a typical Micro 64 connector. Depress the lock and pull the lever over and past the lock. Page 6487 breakers are used. CIRCUIT BREAKER This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high current is removed. POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) CIRCUIT BREAKER This type greatly increases its resistance when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker will re-close within a second or 2. Circuit Protection - Fuses CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSES The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and examine the element in the fuse for an open (2). If not broken (1), also check for continuity using a DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one of equal current rating. Circuit Protection - Fusible Links CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSIBLE LINKS Page 891 View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. 4. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers CIRCUIT PROTECTION - CIRCUIT BREAKERS A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types of circuit Page 1046 Behind Driver Seat Page 1562 Page 6211 - In some cases Delphi will actually be printed on the connector. If Delphi is not printed on the connector, look for PED. In both cases there is no specific orientation for Delphi or PED and they can appear anywhere on the connector. - FCI connectors may have the FCI logo on their connectors. The logo is the letters FCI with an "A" above it. - JAE connector have JAE in small letters on their connectors. Page 3521 10. Using the tire machine, rotate the tire/wheel assembly clockwise when transferring the tire bead to the inside of the wheel rim. 11. Position the rim so that the valve stem (1) is situated at the 3 o'clock position relative to the head (2). This will protect the sensor when the bottom bead seats. 12. After the bottom bead is on the wheel, reposition the wheel and tire so that the valve stem is situated at the 9 o'clock position relative to the head. This will protect the sensor while mounting the tire bead to the outside of the wheel. Page 5252 Engine Control Module (ECM) C3 (Pin 16 To 59) Page 8607 Knock Sensor: Description and Operation Knock Sensor (KS) System Description Purpose The knock sensor (KS) system enables the control module to control the ignition timing for the best possible performance while protecting the engine from potentially damaging levels of detonation. The control module uses the KS system to test for abnormal engine noise that may indicate detonation, also known as spark knock. Sensor Description This knock sensor (KS) system uses one or 2 flat response 2-wire sensors. The sensor uses piezo-electric crystal technology that produces an AC voltage signal of varying amplitude and frequency based on the engine vibration or noise level. The control module receives the KS signal through a signal circuit. The KS ground is supplied by the control module through a low reference circuit. The control module learns a minimum noise level, or background noise, at idle from the KS and uses calibrated values for the rest of the RPM range. The control module uses the minimum noise level to calculate a noise channel. A normal KS signal will ride within the noise channel. As engine speed and load change, the noise channel upper and lower parameters will change to accommodate the normal KS signal, keeping the signal within the channel. In order to determine which cylinders are knocking, the control module only uses KS signal information when each cylinder is near top dead center (TDC) of the firing stroke. If knock is present, the signal will range outside of the noise channel. If the control module has determined that knock is present, it will retard the ignition timing to attempt to eliminate the knock. The control module will always try to work back to a zero compensation level, or no spark retard. An abnormal KS signal will stay outside of the noise channel or will not be present. KS diagnostics are calibrated to detect faults with the KS circuitry inside the control module, the KS wiring, or the KS voltage output. Some diagnostics are also calibrated to detect constant noise from an outside influence such as a loose/damaged component or excessive engine mechanical noise. Page 2580 Connector Anatomy Connector Repairs contains a list of all connector repairs. The connector repairs are listed by the connector manufacturer and then by connector type. If the technician cannot identify the manufacturer of the connector, refer to Identifying Connectors below. Knowing the connector manufacturer will assist in finding the correct connector repair from the following list: - Connector Position Assurance Locks - Terminal Position Assurance Locks - Bosch Connectors (0.64) Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) Bosch Connectors (BSK) Bosch Connectors (ECM) - Delphi Connectors (Micro.64) Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) Delphi Connectors (12-Way) - Tyco/AMP Connectors (CM 42-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) Tyco/AMP Connectors (025 Cap) Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) - Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) - Repairing Connector Terminals IDENTIFYING CONNECTORS Knowing the connector manufacturer is helpful when trying to locating the correct connector repair procedure. There are many different connector designs used on GM vehicles and it is sometimes difficult to identify the connector manufacturer. The information in this document should help with the identification of connector manufactures. The following connector manufacturers make most of the connectors found in GM vehicles: AFL/EPC (Alcoa Fujikura Ltd./Engineered Plastics Components) - Bosch - Delphi - FCI (Framatome Connectors International) - JAE (Japan Aviation Electronics) - JST (Japan Solderless Terminals) Page 5874 View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. 4. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers CIRCUIT PROTECTION - CIRCUIT BREAKERS A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types of circuit Page 8452 Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size. REPAIRING A FUSIBLE LINK IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient overload protection. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. Flat Wire Repairs FLAT WIRE REPAIRS NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced. GMLAN Wiring Repairs GMLAN WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The GM Local Area Network (GMLAN) System requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working on GMLAN connectors and terminals. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items in order to repair the GMLAN wiring: Dura Seal splice sleeves - A wire stripping tool - J 38125-8 Crimping Tool (GM P/N 12085115) - J 38125-5 Ultra Torch Special Tool (GM P/N 12085116) The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. - A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors GMLAN REPAIRS IMPORTANT: When making a repair to any GMLAN network, the original wire length after the repair must be the same length as before the repair. If the network is a twisted pair, the twist must be maintained after the repair is completed. GMLAN has 2 types of networks, low speed and high speed. Low speed GMLAN has a single wire and works at slow speeds. High speed GMLAN has 2 wires in a twisted pair and works at higher speeds. For more information on GMLAN, refer to Data Link Communications Description and Operation. GMLAN CONNECTOR TERMINAL REPAIR IMPORTANT: A service terminal can be used to replace damaged connector terminals for both high speed and low speed GMLAN systems. When making a connector terminal repair on a GMLAN high speed system with twisted pair wires, do not untwist the wires more than necessary to make the repair. The terminals in the GMLAN system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are available in the J-38125. If the individual terminals are damaged on any GMLAN connection, use the appropriate connector repair procedure in order to repair the terminal. GMLAN WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 3452 Fuse Block - Rear C2 (Pin E4 To F12) Tire Pressure Sensor Grommet Replacement Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Sensor Grommet Replacement Tire Pressure Sensor Grommet Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Raise the vehicle on a suitable support. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 2. Remove the tire/wheel assembly from the vehicle. Refer to Tire and Wheel Removal and Installation. Important: Before the tire is removed from the wheel, note the following items to avoid tire pressure sensor damage upon tire dismounting: ^ Place the sensors cap and valve on a dry clean surface after removal, the cap is aluminum and the valve is nickel plated to prevent corrosion and are not to be substituted with a cap or valve made of any other material. ^ Position the bead breaking fixture 90 degrees from the valve stem when separating the tire bead from the wheel. ^ Position the mounting/dismounting head so the tire iron, or pry bar can be inserted slightly clockwise of the sensor body when prying the tire bead up and over the mounting/dismounting head. ^ Using the tire machine, rotate the tire/wheel assembly clockwise when transferring the tire bead to the outside of the wheel rim. ^ Repeat items for inner bead. Remove the tire from the wheel. Refer to Tire Mounting and Dismounting. Important: If any tire sealant is noted upon tire dismounting, replace the sensor. Refer to Tire Pressure Sensor Replacement. Also remove all residual liquid sealant from the inside of the tire and wheel surfaces. ^ Remove the tire pressure sensor nut. ^ Remove the sensor from the wheel hole. ^ Remove the sensor grommet from the valve stem. Installation Procedure 1. Clean any dirt or debris from the grommet sealing areas. 2. Install the grommet on the sensor valve stem. Page 1331 11. Insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) into the 2 triangular cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 12. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE 1. Prior to installation the terminal must be aligned so the (1) coding lugs align with the (2) coding grooves on the connector. 2. Once the terminal is aligned, slide the terminal into the cavity until the retainer has engaged in the cavity of the connector. 3. Slide the TPA in the connector body and seat it using a small flat bladed tool. The TPA is seated when it is flush with the contact housing. 4. Secure the wires to the connector body using a tie wrap and replace the dress cover and grommet. Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) BOSCH CONNECTORS (2.8 JPT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Pull out the slider on the connector position assurance (CPA) until it is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 6910 pulling it through. This will prevent damage to the internal seals of the connector. Once the terminal is pushed out of the connector, cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible and pull the wire through the connector. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE The Micro-Pack 100W connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool was developed to crimp Micro-Pack 100W terminals. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 2. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert the terminal into the crimp tool until the core wings are flush with the anvil on the crimp tool. Be sure that the wings are pointed toward the crimp tool former and release the spring locator. The locator will hold the terminal in place. Inspect the alignment of the terminal wings with the crimp tool former. If the terminal wings are wider than the crimp tool former, remove the terminal and bend the terminal wings in slightly. 5. Place stripped wire into terminal. 6. Crimp the new terminal to the wire. If a jam occurs, press the emergency release to open applicator. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire perform the following procedure in order to replace Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. Page 1929 5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape. Seat Belt Schematic Icons Seat Belt Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons Page 7596 Page 7768 5. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove TPA from the connector. 6. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Page 7549 Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size. REPAIRING A FUSIBLE LINK IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient overload protection. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. Flat Wire Repairs FLAT WIRE REPAIRS NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced. GMLAN Wiring Repairs GMLAN WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The GM Local Area Network (GMLAN) System requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working on GMLAN connectors and terminals. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items in order to repair the GMLAN wiring: Dura Seal splice sleeves - A wire stripping tool - J 38125-8 Crimping Tool (GM P/N 12085115) - J 38125-5 Ultra Torch Special Tool (GM P/N 12085116) The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. - A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors GMLAN REPAIRS IMPORTANT: When making a repair to any GMLAN network, the original wire length after the repair must be the same length as before the repair. If the network is a twisted pair, the twist must be maintained after the repair is completed. GMLAN has 2 types of networks, low speed and high speed. Low speed GMLAN has a single wire and works at slow speeds. High speed GMLAN has 2 wires in a twisted pair and works at higher speeds. For more information on GMLAN, refer to Data Link Communications Description and Operation. GMLAN CONNECTOR TERMINAL REPAIR IMPORTANT: A service terminal can be used to replace damaged connector terminals for both high speed and low speed GMLAN systems. When making a connector terminal repair on a GMLAN high speed system with twisted pair wires, do not untwist the wires more than necessary to make the repair. The terminals in the GMLAN system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are available in the J-38125. If the individual terminals are damaged on any GMLAN connection, use the appropriate connector repair procedure in order to repair the terminal. GMLAN WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 3129 4. Lower the vehicle. Page 207 Depress the locks that are located on both sides of the wiredress cover and pull the lever over and past the locks. View of the connector when released from the component. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the front of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool push down on one of the locking tabs and pull the cover up until the dress cover releases. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. Page 3299 4. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the rear of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. 5. Once the locking tabs are unlocked, slide the inner connector out of the rear of the connector housing. Diagram Information and Instructions Fuel Pump Relay: Diagram Information and Instructions Electrical Symbols Page 6452 Release the lower wiredress cover locking tab. Release the upper wiredress cover locking tab. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. Page 2357 4. Use a small flat-blade tool to slide the terminal position assurance (TPA) up one notch on both ends of the connector. The TPA is located underneath the wire dress cover. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 1874 7. Apply pressure and gently rock the cover until one locking leg is unseated. 8. Continue to apply pressure and rock the cover until the second locking leg is unseated. Repeat procedure for the other side of the dress cover and remove the cover. 9. Use J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) to gently lift the terminal retaining tab while gently pulling the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 10. If the terminal is severely bent or damaged, it may be possible on some connectors to push the wire out of the front of the connector instead of Page 8256 11. Insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) into the 2 triangular cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 12. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE 1. Prior to installation the terminal must be aligned so the (1) coding lugs align with the (2) coding grooves on the connector. 2. Once the terminal is aligned, slide the terminal into the cavity until the retainer has engaged in the cavity of the connector. 3. Slide the TPA in the connector body and seat it using a small flat bladed tool. The TPA is seated when it is flush with the contact housing. 4. Secure the wires to the connector body using a tie wrap and replace the dress cover and grommet. Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) BOSCH CONNECTORS (2.8 JPT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Pull out the slider on the connector position assurance (CPA) until it is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 8547 pulling it through. This will prevent damage to the internal seals of the connector. Once the terminal is pushed out of the connector, cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible and pull the wire through the connector. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE The Micro-Pack 100W connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool was developed to crimp Micro-Pack 100W terminals. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 2. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert the terminal into the crimp tool until the core wings are flush with the anvil on the crimp tool. Be sure that the wings are pointed toward the crimp tool former and release the spring locator. The locator will hold the terminal in place. Inspect the alignment of the terminal wings with the crimp tool former. If the terminal wings are wider than the crimp tool former, remove the terminal and bend the terminal wings in slightly. 5. Place stripped wire into terminal. 6. Crimp the new terminal to the wire. If a jam occurs, press the emergency release to open applicator. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire perform the following procedure in order to replace Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. Page 4812 7. Apply pressure and gently rock the cover until one locking leg is unseated. 8. Continue to apply pressure and rock the cover until the second locking leg is unseated. Repeat procedure for the other side of the dress cover and remove the cover. 9. Use J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) to gently lift the terminal retaining tab while gently pulling the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 10. If the terminal is severely bent or damaged, it may be possible on some connectors to push the wire out of the front of the connector instead of Page 1796 Knock Sensor: Description and Operation Knock Sensor (KS) System Description Purpose The knock sensor (KS) system enables the control module to control the ignition timing for the best possible performance while protecting the engine from potentially damaging levels of detonation. The control module uses the KS system to test for abnormal engine noise that may indicate detonation, also known as spark knock. Sensor Description This knock sensor (KS) system uses one or 2 flat response 2-wire sensors. The sensor uses piezo-electric crystal technology that produces an AC voltage signal of varying amplitude and frequency based on the engine vibration or noise level. The control module receives the KS signal through a signal circuit. The KS ground is supplied by the control module through a low reference circuit. The control module learns a minimum noise level, or background noise, at idle from the KS and uses calibrated values for the rest of the RPM range. The control module uses the minimum noise level to calculate a noise channel. A normal KS signal will ride within the noise channel. As engine speed and load change, the noise channel upper and lower parameters will change to accommodate the normal KS signal, keeping the signal within the channel. In order to determine which cylinders are knocking, the control module only uses KS signal information when each cylinder is near top dead center (TDC) of the firing stroke. If knock is present, the signal will range outside of the noise channel. If the control module has determined that knock is present, it will retard the ignition timing to attempt to eliminate the knock. The control module will always try to work back to a zero compensation level, or no spark retard. An abnormal KS signal will stay outside of the noise channel or will not be present. KS diagnostics are calibrated to detect faults with the KS circuitry inside the control module, the KS wiring, or the KS voltage output. Some diagnostics are also calibrated to detect constant noise from an outside influence such as a loose/damaged component or excessive engine mechanical noise. Service and Repair Maintenance Required Lamp/Indicator: Service and Repair SERVICE VEHICLE SOON or SERVICE ENGINE SOON INDICATOR Your vehicle is equipped with a "SERVICE VEHICLE SOON"or a "SERVICE ENGINE SOON" indicator. This indicator is not a maintenance indicator and does not mean a maintenance service is required. For additional "SERVICE VEHICLE SOON"or a "SERVICE ENGINE SOON" indicator information refer to Malfunction Indicator Lamp. For Maintenance Required Lamp/Indicator, refer to Oil Change Reminder Lamp. See: Oil Change Reminder Lamp/Service and Repair Page 5872 6. Gently pry the plastic terminal retainer down and carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (16-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, pull the two connector halves apart. Page 6315 difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Bosch Connectors (ECM) BOSCH CONNECTORS (ECM) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the assist lever on the top of the connector. Move the assist lever to the forward position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 611 Body Control Module (BCM) C3 Page 2244 Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. FCI Connectors FCI CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 8549 TERMINAL REMOVAL Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors. 1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA) device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1). 3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 4. Gently pull the cable and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector. 5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal, refer to Terminal Repair. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3. Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector. REINSTALLING TERMINAL 1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly, refer to Wiring Repairs. 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3. Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) DELPHI CONNECTORS (WEATHER PACK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 5255 Engine Control Module: Description and Operation Engine Control Module Description The powertrain has electronic controls to reduce exhaust emissions while maintaining excellent driveability and fuel economy. The engine control module (ECM) is the control center of this system. The ECM monitors numerous engine and vehicle functions. The ECM constantly monitors the information from various sensors and other inputs, and controls the systems that affect vehicle performance and emissions. The ECM also performs the diagnostic tests on various parts of the system. The ECM can recognize operational problems and alert the driver via the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL). When the ECM detects a malfunction, the ECM stores a diagnostic trouble code (DTC). The problem area is identified by the particular DTC that is set. The control module supplies a buffered voltage to various sensors and switches. Review the components and wiring diagrams in order to determine which systems are controlled by the ECM. Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) Operation The malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) is located in the instrument panel cluster. The MIL will display as either SERVICE ENGINE SOON or one of the following symbols when commanded ON: The MIL indicates that an emissions related fault has occurred and vehicle service is required. The following is a list of the modes of operation for the MIL: * The MIL illuminates when the ignition is turned ON, with the engine OFF. This is a bulb test to ensure the MIL is able to illuminate. * The MIL turns OFF after the engine is started if a diagnostic fault is not present. * The MIL remains illuminated after the engine is started if the control module detects a fault. A diagnostic trouble code (DTC) is stored any time the control module illuminates the MIL due to an emissions related fault. The MIL turns OFF after three consecutive ignition cycles in which a Test Passed has been reported for the diagnostic test that originally caused the MIL to illuminate. * The MIL flashes if the control module detects a misfire condition which could damage the catalytic converter. * When the MIL is illuminated and the engine stalls, the MIL will remain illuminated as long as the ignition is ON. * When the MIL is not illuminated and the engine stalls, the MIL will not illuminate until the ignition is cycled OFF and then ON. Page 7358 4. Once the front 2 locks are unlocked, lift the front of the dress cover and pull it forward. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the small slot on the TPA and pushing down until the TPA releases. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to angle or rock the J 38125-21 tool when inserting it into the connector or the tool may break. Insert the J 38125-21 (GM P/N 15381651-2) tool into the round canal between the terminals cavities at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to repair Micro 64 connector terminals. The Micro 64 connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-64 (M jaw) was developed to crimp Micro 64 terminals. The J 38125-64 crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. The J 38125-64 crimping tool is also designed to crimp both the wire and the insulation at the same time. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro 64 terminals. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. 1. Cut the wire as close to the damaged terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. Page 4441 View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. 4. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers CIRCUIT PROTECTION - CIRCUIT BREAKERS A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types of circuit Page 205 View of a typical Micro 64 connector. Depress the lock and pull the lever over and past the lock. Page 8760 1. If reinstalling the old sensor, coat the threads with anti-seize compound GM P/N 12377953, or equivalent. Notice: Refer to Component Fastener Tightening Notice. 2. Install the HO2S (2). Tighten the sensor to 42 N.m (31 lb ft). 3. Connect the HO2S electrical connector (1). 4. Install the CPA retainer. 5. Lower the vehicle. Page 3978 Valve Spring: Service and Repair Valve Stem Oil Seal and Valve Spring Replacement Tools Required ^ J 22794 Spark Plug Port Adapter ^ J 38606 Valve Spring Compressor Removal Procedure 1. Remove the valve rocker arm. Refer to Valve Rocker Arm and Push Rod Replacement. 2. Disconnect the spark plug wire at the spark plug. ^ Twist each plug wire boot 1/2 turn. ^ Pull only on the boot in order to remove the wire from the spark plug. Important: Remove the spark plugs from the cylinder head with the engine at room temperature. Page 1721 5. Insert the J 38125-557 (GM P/N 12122378) into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 6. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Connector Position Assurance Locks CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of the connector. CPAs are used in various connectors throughout the vehicle. CPAs are also used in all SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals, of the connector. Connector Repairs CONNECTOR REPAIRS Page 3786 Release the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the blue locking tabs on both ends of the connector. Gently slide the TPA up to the released position on both ends. 6. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-13A (GM P/N 12031876-1) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. Page 1867 View of a typical Micro 64 connector. Depress the lock and pull the lever over and past the lock. Page 2383 View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. View of the release tool being used for the smaller terminals. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (2-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 2770 13. Inspect the transmission fluid pressure manual valve position switch assembly for the following conditions: ^ Damage ^ Debris ^ Damaged or missing O-rings ^ Cracked connector ^ Loose electrical terminals ^ Poor terminal retention 14. Remove the manual detent spring retaining bolt. 15. Remove the manual detent spring. 16. Inspect the manual detent spring for cracks or damage. Important: Keep the control valve body level when lowering it from the vehicle. This will prevent the loss of checkballs located in the control valve body passages. 17. Remove the remaining control valve body bolts. Page 4525 View of typical connector. View of connector in released position. 1. Locate the assist lever at the back of the connector. Move the assist lever to the rear position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the dress cover. Page 7655 4. Slide the dress cover forward and off of the connector. 5. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front and rear of the connector. Page 7758 It is very important to use the correct test adapter when testing for proper terminal contact of fuses and relays in a bussed electrical center (BEC). Use J-35616-35 to test for proper terminal contact. Failure to use J-35616-35 can result in improper diagnosis of the BEC. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Separate the connector halves. 2. Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body. 3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J-38125 , test that the retention force is significantly different between a good terminal and a suspect terminal. Replace the female terminal in question. FLAT WIRE (DOCK AND LOCK) CONNECTORS There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock) connectors on the harness side or the component side. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Remove the component in question. 2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side of the connector as oil from your skin may be a source of contamination as well. 3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other imperfections that could cause poor terminal contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are uniform and free of damage or deformation. 4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the on the flat wire harness connector in order to test the circuit in question. CONTROL MODULE/COMPONENT VOLTAGE AND GROUNDS Poor voltage or ground connections can cause widely varying symptoms. Test all control module voltage supply circuits. Many vehicles have multiple circuits supplying voltage to a control module. Other components in the system may have separate voltage supply circuits that may also need to be tested. Inspect connections at the module/component connectors, fuses, and any intermediate connections between the voltage source and the module/component. A test lamp or a DMM may indicate that voltage is present, but neither tests the ability of the circuit to carry sufficient current. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Power Distribution Schematics. - Test all control module ground and system ground circuits. The control module may have multiple ground circuits. Other components in the system may have separate grounds that may also need to be tested. Inspect grounds for clean and tight connections at the grounding point. Inspect the connections at the component and in splice packs, where applicable. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Ground Distribution Schematics. TEMPERATURE SENSITIVITY - An intermittent condition may occur when a component/connection reaches normal operating temperature. The condition may occur only when the component/connection is cold, or only when the component/connection is hot. - Freeze Frame, Failure Records, Snapshot, or Vehicle Data Recorder data may help with this type of intermittent condition, where applicable. - If the intermittent is related to heat, review the data for a relationship with the following: High ambient temperatures - Underhood/engine generated heat - Circuit generated heat due to a poor connection, or high electrical load - Higher than normal load conditions, towing, etc. - If the intermittent is related to cold, review the data for the following: Low ambient temperatures-In extremely low temperatures, ice may form in a connection or component. Inspect for water intrusion. - The condition only occurs on a cold start. - The condition goes away when the vehicle warms up. - Information from the customer may help to determine if the trouble follows a pattern that is temperature related. - If temperature is suspected of causing an intermittent fault condition, attempt to duplicate the condition. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required. ELECTROMAGNETIC INTERFERENCE (EMI) AND ELECTRICAL NOISE Some electrical components/circuits are sensitive to electromagnetic interference (EMI) or other types of electrical noise. Inspect for the following conditions: A misrouted harness that is too close to high voltage/high current devices such as secondary ignition components, motors, generator etc-These components may induce electrical noise on a circuit that could interfere with normal circuit operation. - Electrical system interference caused by a malfunctioning relay, or a control module driven solenoid or switch-These conditions can cause a sharp electrical surge. Normally, the condition will occur when the malfunctioning component is operating. - Improper installation of non-factory or aftermarket add on accessories such as lights, 2-way radios, amplifiers, electric motors, remote starters, alarm systems, cell phones, etc-These accessories may lead to interference while in use, but do not fail when the accessories are not in use. - Test for an open diode across the A/C compressor clutch and for other open diodes. Some relays may contain a clamping diode. - The generator may be allowing AC noise into the electrical system. INCORRECT CONTROL MODULE - There are only a few situations where reprogramming a control module is appropriate: A new service control module is installed. Page 4236 4. Use the J 41478 (1) and the J 41665 (2) in order to install the crankshaft sprocket. Install the sprocket onto the crankshaft until fully seated against the crankshaft flange. 5. Rotate the crankshaft sprocket until the alignment mark is in the 12 o'clock position. 6. Compress the timing chain tensioner guide and install the EN 46330. Page 5886 11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the solder equipment. 12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. 13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to cover the first piece of tape. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE SLEEVES TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit IMPORTANT: Use only dura seal splice sleeves. Other splice sleeves may not protect the splice from moisture or provide a good electrical connection. Use duraseal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. Use duraseal splice sleeves where there is special requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire using duraseal splice sleeves. Page 7559 11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the solder equipment. 12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. 13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to cover the first piece of tape. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE SLEEVES TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit IMPORTANT: Use only dura seal splice sleeves. Other splice sleeves may not protect the splice from moisture or provide a good electrical connection. Use duraseal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. Use duraseal splice sleeves where there is special requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire using duraseal splice sleeves. Page 7560 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches, and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original. - The wires insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the possibility of fuel contact. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1). 5. Select the proper duraseal splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool. Refer to the Crimp and Seal Splice Table. 6. Place the duraseal splice sleeve in the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115) crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 7. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to hold the duraseal splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 8. Insert the wires into the duraseal splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel in order to prevent the wire from passing through the splice (3). 9. Close the handles of the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115), until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is applied to the splice sleeve. 10. Shrink the insulation around the splice. - Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. - Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Splicing Inline Harness Diodes SPLICING INLINE HARNESS DIODES Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure. 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode. 2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool. 5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode. Page 2559 vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide variety of actions, including: - Wiggling the harness - Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting - Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector - Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation - Relocating a harness or wires All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. Another option is, with the component commanded ON and OFF by the scan tool, move related connectors and wiring and observe the component operation. With the engine running, move related connectors and wiring while monitoring engine operation. If harness or connector movement affects the data displayed, component/system operation, or engine operation, inspect and repair the harness/connections as necessary. You may need to load the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these cases you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide good results as well. There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions, along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the circuit to these kinds of conditions. SALT WATER SPRAY Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture. Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5 percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously. HIGH TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070. Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault condition. The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis. This option does not allow for the same control, however. LOW TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect. If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to -18°C (0°F) from one end and +71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized cooling needs. Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or components in an effort to duplicate the concern. DUPLICATING FAILURE CONDITIONS - If none of the previous tests are successful, attempt to duplicate and/or capture the failure conditions. Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, where applicable, contains the conditions that were present when the DTC set. 1. Review and record Freeze Frame/Failure Records data. 2. Clear the DTCs using the scan tool. 3. Turn the key to OFF and wait 15 seconds. 4. Operate the vehicle under the same conditions that were noted in Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, as closely as possible. The vehicle must also be operating within the Conditions for Running the DTC. Refer to Conditions for Running the DTC in the supporting text if a DTC is being diagnosed. 5. Monitor DTC Status for the DTC being tested. The scan tool will indicate Ran, when the enabling conditions have been satisfied long enough for the DTC to run. The scan tool will also indicate whether the DTC passed or failed. - An alternate method is to drive the vehicle with the DMM connected to a suspected circuit. An abnormal reading on the DMM when the concern occurs, may help you locate the concern. Measuring Frequency Page 769 6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias. Reference the appropriate service manual wiring schematic to obtain the correct diode installation position. 7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for the soldering equipment. 8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed. 9. IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode attachment points with tape. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape. Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable SPLICING TWISTED OR SHIELDED CABLE Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable. 1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splice is made. 3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire. Staggering the splices by 65 mm (2.5 in) is recommended. 4. IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical contact with the drain wire. Re-assemble the cable. Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape. - Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1). - Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire. - Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape. Page 4639 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. 4. Remove the dress cover by using a flat bladed tool to release the dress cover locking tabs and lift up on the dress cover. 5. Cut the tie wrap that holds the wires to the connector body. Page 6093 View of the connector when released from the component. View of another type of Micro 64 connector. Page 3663 1. Install the splash shield to the steering knuckle. Align the splash shield to the steering knuckle threaded holes. 2. Install the wheel hub and bearing to the steering knuckle. Align the threaded holes. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 3. Install the wheel hub and bearing to the steering knuckle mounting bolts. Tighten the wheel hub and bearing mounting bolts to 105 N.m (77 lb ft). 4. Install the ABS sensor to the wheel hub and bearing. 5. Install the ABS sensor mounting bolt to the wheel hub and bearing. Tighten the ABS sensor to the wheel hub and bearing mounting bolt to 18 N.m (13 lb ft). 6. Install the brake rotor. Refer to Front Brake Rotor Replacement. 7. Install the tire and wheel. Refer to Tire and Wheel Removal and Installation. 8. Lower the vehicle. Page 6493 11. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 12. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 13. Center the high temperature SCT1 shrink tube over the DuraSeal splice sleeve. 14. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the high temperature heat shrink tubing. 15. Gradually move the heat from the center to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 16. Replace any reflective tape and clips that may have been remove during the repair. Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation REPAIRING DAMAGED WIRE INSULATION Wire Size Conversion Page 6296 All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system. Page 7106 Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Camshaft Position Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Remove the generator bracket assembly. 2. Remove the camshaft position sensor mounting bolts (1). 3. Remove the camshaft position sensor assembly (4, 5, 6) from the front cover (7). 4. Disconnect the camshaft position sensor jumper harness (2) and the engine harness (3) electrical connectors. 5. Remove the camshaft sensor assembly (4, 5, 6). 6. Disconnect camshaft position sensor (5) from the jumper harness (4). Installation Procedure 1. Reconnect the camshaft sensor (5) and the jumper harness (4). 2. Install the O-ring (6) on the camshaft sensor assembly (4, 5). 3. Reconnect the camshaft position sensor assembly (4, 5, 6) and the engine harness connector (3). Page 2645 11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the solder equipment. 12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. 13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to cover the first piece of tape. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE SLEEVES TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit IMPORTANT: Use only dura seal splice sleeves. Other splice sleeves may not protect the splice from moisture or provide a good electrical connection. Use duraseal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. Use duraseal splice sleeves where there is special requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire using duraseal splice sleeves. Page 3398 2. Locate the two indents of the terminal position assurance (TPA) located on the bottom of the connector body. Page 4861 If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the DuraSeal splice sleeves. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: - Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. - Do not use the crimp and DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 to crimp DuraSeal splice sleeve. In order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 2152 2. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 8921 Depress the locks that are located on both sides of the wiredress cover and pull the lever over and past the locks. View of the connector when released from the component. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the front of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool push down on one of the locking tabs and pull the cover up until the dress cover releases. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. Page 8727 Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size. REPAIRING A FUSIBLE LINK IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient overload protection. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. Flat Wire Repairs FLAT WIRE REPAIRS NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced. GMLAN Wiring Repairs GMLAN WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The GM Local Area Network (GMLAN) System requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working on GMLAN connectors and terminals. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items in order to repair the GMLAN wiring: Dura Seal splice sleeves - A wire stripping tool - J 38125-8 Crimping Tool (GM P/N 12085115) - J 38125-5 Ultra Torch Special Tool (GM P/N 12085116) The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. - A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors GMLAN REPAIRS IMPORTANT: When making a repair to any GMLAN network, the original wire length after the repair must be the same length as before the repair. If the network is a twisted pair, the twist must be maintained after the repair is completed. GMLAN has 2 types of networks, low speed and high speed. Low speed GMLAN has a single wire and works at slow speeds. High speed GMLAN has 2 wires in a twisted pair and works at higher speeds. For more information on GMLAN, refer to Data Link Communications Description and Operation. GMLAN CONNECTOR TERMINAL REPAIR IMPORTANT: A service terminal can be used to replace damaged connector terminals for both high speed and low speed GMLAN systems. When making a connector terminal repair on a GMLAN high speed system with twisted pair wires, do not untwist the wires more than necessary to make the repair. The terminals in the GMLAN system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are available in the J-38125. If the individual terminals are damaged on any GMLAN connection, use the appropriate connector repair procedure in order to repair the terminal. GMLAN WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 3719 IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals. Front probe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the connector. IMPORTANT: When probing female 0.64 terminals, it is important to use the correct adapter. There have been some revisions to the test adapter for 0.64 terminals. The proper adapter for 0.64 terminals is the J 35616-64B which has a gold terminal and a black wire between the base and tip. Failure to use the proper test adapter may result in damage to the terminal being tested and improper diagnosis. NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Page 5116 Remove all rust from the ground terminal, the cylinder head and the retaining nut or bolt. Position the main engine wiring harness ground terminal and install the nut or bolt. Tighten: Tighten the retaining nut or bolt to 16 N.m (12 lb ft). Apply some type of electrical moisture sealant to protect the harness terminal from further corrosion. Disclaimer Page 7518 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. JST Connectors JST CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, remove the connector from the component. Heated Oxygen and Oxygen Sensor Notice Oxygen Sensor: Service Precautions Heated Oxygen and Oxygen Sensor Notice Heated Oxygen and Oxygen Sensor Notice Notice: Do not remove the pigtail from either the heated oxygen sensor (HO2S) or the oxygen sensor (O2S). Removing the pigtail or the connector will affect sensor operation. Handle the oxygen sensor carefully. Do not drop the HO2S. Keep the in-line electrical connector and the louvered end free of grease, dirt, or other contaminants. Do not use cleaning solvents of any type. Do not repair the wiring, connector or terminals. Replace the oxygen sensor if the pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged. This external clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors, or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degraded sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: * Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. * Do not damage the sensor pigtail and harness wires in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. * Ensure the sensor or vehicle lead wires are not bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends or kinks could block the reference air path through the lead wire. * Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire, where applicable. Vehicles that utilize the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will cause poor engine performance. * Ensure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector in order to prevent damage due to water intrusion. The engine harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air reference being obstructed. Page 5247 Engine Control Module (ECM) C1 (Pin 16 To 56) Engine Control Module (ECM) C2 Page 389 The first connector design of the Micro-Pack 100W (1) has a white connector interface that holds the terminals. The second design of the Micro-Pack 100W (2) has a gray interface to hold the terminals. Also, the first design has terminal cavities that are further apart (3 mm centerline) and offset from the other row of terminal cavities in the connector. The second design has terminals cavities that are closer together (2.54 mm centerline) and aligned vertically. One other way to identify the second design is the thin strip of material that runs along the outside of the cavities. IMPORTANT: There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W terminals which are very similar. Ensure that you have the correct terminal before crimping the new terminal to the wire. The first design connector uses the longer terminal (1) that has a raised area in front of the recess in the terminal. The second design connector uses the shorter terminal without the raised area. Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro-Pack 100W connectors. Some Micro-Pack 100W connector disassembly procedures will vary. Use this procedure as a guide. 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 1212 4. Remove the fuel sender assembly (2) and seal (3). Discard the seal. Caution: Refer to Fuel Storage Caution. 5. Clean the fuel sender sealing surfaces (4). Important: Some lock ring were manufactured with DO NOT REUSE stamped into them. These lock rings may be reused if they are not damaged or warped. Important: Inspect the lock ring for damage due to improper removal or installation procedures. If damage is found, install a NEW lock ring. Important: Check the lock ring for flatness. 6. Place the lock ring on a flat surface. Measure the clearance between to lock ring and the flat surface using a feeler gage at 7 points. 7. If the warpage is less than 0.41 mm (0.016 in), the lock ring does not require replacement. 8. If the warpage is greater than 0.41 mm (0.016 in), the lock ring must be replaced. Installation Procedure Page 5204 MOLEX CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. 2. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. Page 8041 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Communication Interface Module Replacement (TrailBlazer EXT, Envoy XL) Central Control Module: Service and Repair Communication Interface Module Replacement (TrailBlazer EXT, Envoy XL) Communication Interface Module Replacement (TrailBlazer EXT, Envoy XL) Removal Procedure Important: Do not exchange the vehicle communication interface module with other vehicles. Each vehicle communication interface module has a specific station identification (STID) and electronic serial number (ESN). These identification numbers are stored in the General Motors vehicle history files by VIN and used by OnStar(R) and the National Cellular Telephone Network. 1. Fold and tumble the right second row seat to a cargo position. 2. Remove the protective cover (1) from the vehicle communication interface module (VCIM). 3. Remove the VCIM from the bracket by releasing the retaining tab (1). 4. Remove the electrical connectors from the VCIM. 5. Remove the VCIM from the vehicle. Installation Procedure 1. If replacing the VCIM, record the 10-digit STID number, and the 11-digit ESN number from the labels on the new module. 2. Position the VCIM near the mounting location. 3. Install the quick connector to the VCIM. Page 8804 View of a typical Micro 64 connector. Depress the lock and pull the lever over and past the lock. Page 8711 9. The illustration shows a cutaway view of the connector to aid the technician in releasing the terminal retainer. 10. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Terminal Position Assurance Locks TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Tyco/Amp Connectors (CM 42-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (CM 42-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the connector body and pull the CPA out. The CPA is on the wire harness side of connector. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 7129 Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Specifications Temperature Versus Resistance Page 3389 TERMINAL REMOVAL Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors. 1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA) device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1). 3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 4. Gently pull the cable and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector. 5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal, refer to Terminal Repair. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3. Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector. REINSTALLING TERMINAL 1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly, refer to Wiring Repairs. 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3. Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) DELPHI CONNECTORS (WEATHER PACK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 8518 It is very important to use the correct test adapter when testing for proper terminal contact of fuses and relays in a bussed electrical center (BEC). Use J-35616-35 to test for proper terminal contact. Failure to use J-35616-35 can result in improper diagnosis of the BEC. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Separate the connector halves. 2. Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body. 3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J-38125 , test that the retention force is significantly different between a good terminal and a suspect terminal. Replace the female terminal in question. FLAT WIRE (DOCK AND LOCK) CONNECTORS There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock) connectors on the harness side or the component side. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Remove the component in question. 2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side of the connector as oil from your skin may be a source of contamination as well. 3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other imperfections that could cause poor terminal contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are uniform and free of damage or deformation. 4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the on the flat wire harness connector in order to test the circuit in question. CONTROL MODULE/COMPONENT VOLTAGE AND GROUNDS Poor voltage or ground connections can cause widely varying symptoms. Test all control module voltage supply circuits. Many vehicles have multiple circuits supplying voltage to a control module. Other components in the system may have separate voltage supply circuits that may also need to be tested. Inspect connections at the module/component connectors, fuses, and any intermediate connections between the voltage source and the module/component. A test lamp or a DMM may indicate that voltage is present, but neither tests the ability of the circuit to carry sufficient current. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Power Distribution Schematics. - Test all control module ground and system ground circuits. The control module may have multiple ground circuits. Other components in the system may have separate grounds that may also need to be tested. Inspect grounds for clean and tight connections at the grounding point. Inspect the connections at the component and in splice packs, where applicable. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Ground Distribution Schematics. TEMPERATURE SENSITIVITY - An intermittent condition may occur when a component/connection reaches normal operating temperature. The condition may occur only when the component/connection is cold, or only when the component/connection is hot. - Freeze Frame, Failure Records, Snapshot, or Vehicle Data Recorder data may help with this type of intermittent condition, where applicable. - If the intermittent is related to heat, review the data for a relationship with the following: High ambient temperatures - Underhood/engine generated heat - Circuit generated heat due to a poor connection, or high electrical load - Higher than normal load conditions, towing, etc. - If the intermittent is related to cold, review the data for the following: Low ambient temperatures-In extremely low temperatures, ice may form in a connection or component. Inspect for water intrusion. - The condition only occurs on a cold start. - The condition goes away when the vehicle warms up. - Information from the customer may help to determine if the trouble follows a pattern that is temperature related. - If temperature is suspected of causing an intermittent fault condition, attempt to duplicate the condition. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required. ELECTROMAGNETIC INTERFERENCE (EMI) AND ELECTRICAL NOISE Some electrical components/circuits are sensitive to electromagnetic interference (EMI) or other types of electrical noise. Inspect for the following conditions: A misrouted harness that is too close to high voltage/high current devices such as secondary ignition components, motors, generator etc-These components may induce electrical noise on a circuit that could interfere with normal circuit operation. - Electrical system interference caused by a malfunctioning relay, or a control module driven solenoid or switch-These conditions can cause a sharp electrical surge. Normally, the condition will occur when the malfunctioning component is operating. - Improper installation of non-factory or aftermarket add on accessories such as lights, 2-way radios, amplifiers, electric motors, remote starters, alarm systems, cell phones, etc-These accessories may lead to interference while in use, but do not fail when the accessories are not in use. - Test for an open diode across the A/C compressor clutch and for other open diodes. Some relays may contain a clamping diode. - The generator may be allowing AC noise into the electrical system. INCORRECT CONTROL MODULE - There are only a few situations where reprogramming a control module is appropriate: A new service control module is installed. Page 3282 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully raise the TPA on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA cannot be removed from the connector while there are terminals present in the connector body. View of the TPA when removed from the connector body. 4. Use the J 38125-12A tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the left side of the terminal release cavity as shown in the graphic. Use the tool to move the terminal release to the right with a gentle prying motion. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 1507 11. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 12. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 13. Center the high temperature SCT1 shrink tube over the DuraSeal splice sleeve. 14. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the high temperature heat shrink tubing. 15. Gradually move the heat from the center to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 16. Replace any reflective tape and clips that may have been remove during the repair. Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation REPAIRING DAMAGED WIRE INSULATION Wire Size Conversion Page 4486 3. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. View showing depressing of the lever lock release tab. Page 1214 4. Install the fuel feed (1) and EVAP (2) lines to the sender assembly. 5. Install the fuel tank. Page 5525 vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide variety of actions, including: - Wiggling the harness - Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting - Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector - Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation - Relocating a harness or wires All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. Another option is, with the component commanded ON and OFF by the scan tool, move related connectors and wiring and observe the component operation. With the engine running, move related connectors and wiring while monitoring engine operation. If harness or connector movement affects the data displayed, component/system operation, or engine operation, inspect and repair the harness/connections as necessary. You may need to load the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these cases you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide good results as well. There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions, along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the circuit to these kinds of conditions. SALT WATER SPRAY Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture. Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5 percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously. HIGH TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070. Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault condition. The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis. This option does not allow for the same control, however. LOW TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect. If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to -18°C (0°F) from one end and +71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized cooling needs. Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or components in an effort to duplicate the concern. DUPLICATING FAILURE CONDITIONS - If none of the previous tests are successful, attempt to duplicate and/or capture the failure conditions. Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, where applicable, contains the conditions that were present when the DTC set. 1. Review and record Freeze Frame/Failure Records data. 2. Clear the DTCs using the scan tool. 3. Turn the key to OFF and wait 15 seconds. 4. Operate the vehicle under the same conditions that were noted in Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, as closely as possible. The vehicle must also be operating within the Conditions for Running the DTC. Refer to Conditions for Running the DTC in the supporting text if a DTC is being diagnosed. 5. Monitor DTC Status for the DTC being tested. The scan tool will indicate Ran, when the enabling conditions have been satisfied long enough for the DTC to run. The scan tool will also indicate whether the DTC passed or failed. - An alternate method is to drive the vehicle with the DMM connected to a suspected circuit. An abnormal reading on the DMM when the concern occurs, may help you locate the concern. Measuring Frequency Page 233 8. Insert the J 38125-213 into the small terminal release hole on the nose piece and gently pull on the back of the wire. 9. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Repairing Connector Terminals REPAIRING CONNECTOR TERMINALS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following: Push to Seat terminals - Pull to Seat terminals Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your terminal repair. The J-38125 contains further information. 1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.For cable seal terminals, remove the seal. 2. Apply the correct cable seal per gage size of the wire, if used.Slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation removal. 3. Remove the insulation. 4. For sealed terminals only, align the seal with the end of the cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal.For sealed terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal. 6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.For sealed terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable. 8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals excepting Micro-Pack 100.64 size. Soldering Micro-Pack 100 World terminals may damage the terminal. Sumitomo Connectors SUMITOMO CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 5704 Release the lower wiredress cover locking tab. Release the upper wiredress cover locking tab. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. Page 6156 Page 771 US English/Metric Conversion US English/Metric Conversion Front Suspension Wheel Fastener: Service and Repair Front Suspension Wheel Stud Replacement Tools Required J 43631 Ball Joint Remover Removal Procedure 1. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 2. Remove the tire and the wheel. Refer to Tire and Wheel Removal and Installation. 3. Remove the rotor. Refer to Front Brake Rotor Replacement. Important: Do not hammer on a wheel stud. 4. Remove the wheel stud bolt using J 43631. Installation Procedure 1. Install the wheel stud to the wheel hub and bearing. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Install 4 washers and the nut to the wheel stud. Tighten the wheel stud nut to 140 N.m (103 lb ft), drawing in the wheel stud. 3. Remove the nut and the washers. 4. Install the rotor. Refer to Front Brake Rotor Replacement. 5. Install the tire and the wheel. Refer to Tire and Wheel Removal and Installation. Page 415 5. Once the nose piece retainers are relaxed, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should raise slightly. 6. On the opposite side of the nose piece, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should release completely. If the nose piece does not come off, repeat the procedure on the opposite side. Page 4959 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert a small flat-blade tool in the slot below the front loaded terminal position assurance (TPA) and pry up. 3. Remove the TPA by pulling it out of the connector. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-553 (GM P/N 15315247) on a slight upward angle into the cavity below the terminal to be removed. Ensure that the pointed on the end of the tool is facing the bottom of the terminal and it stays in contact with the terminal until it stops on the plastic terminal retainer. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 8344 Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under the 5 year / 100,000 mile (160,000 km) emission warranty, use: Warranty Information (Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 6514 Page 8781 to analyze the data during the time a vehicle condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a trigger point that you have determined. Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2 snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a first-in, first-out basis. If a third snapshot is taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost. Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types: Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice - Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200 frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not lost if the Scan Tool is powered down. The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis. The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected values by plotting 3 parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful, especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC. Testing for a Short to Voltage TESTING FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4. Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt, there is a short to voltage in the circuit. Testing for Continuity TESTING FOR CONTINUITY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6. Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit. 7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity. With a Test Lamp IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits. 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6. If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity. Testing for Electrical Intermittents TESTING FOR ELECTRICAL INTERMITTENTS Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment. - Testing for Short to Ground - Testing for Continuity - Testing for a Short to Voltage Page 7048 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Ensure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the Terminal Removal Procedure. Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PULL TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL If the terminal is visibly damaged or is suspected of having a faulty connection, the terminal should be replaced. Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors: 1. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) device and/or the secondary lock. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component or separate the connectors for in-line connectors. 3. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device. 4. Insert the proper pick or removal tool into the front of the connector body. 5. IMPORTANT: On connectors with more than one terminal the service loop may not be large enough to remove the terminal and crimp on a new one. If the terminal wire does not have a large enough service loop for removal, cut the wire 5 cm (2 in) behind the connector before removal. Grasp the wire at the back of the connector body and gently push the terminal out the front of the connector body. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. If the wire needed to be cut in order to remove the terminal, gently push a small length of the same size wire through the back of the connector cavity until there is enough wire exposed in order to crimp on a new terminal. If the wire was not cut, cut the existing wire as close to the old terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 4. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. TERMINAL INSTALLATION 1. Align the terminal and pull the wire from the back of the connector in order to seat the terminal. 2. If necessary, cut the new wire to proper length and splice with existing circuit. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. 3. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply dielectric grease to the connector. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PUSH TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 5861 3. Use a small flat-bladed tool to gently pry off the dress cover by inserting the tool under the cover opposite the harness side and prying up. 4. Remove the cover. 5. Using a small flat-bladed tool, push on the side of the nose piece retainer while pushing the nose piece forward with your thumb. This will release the terminal position assurance (TPA). 6. Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) into the corresponding terminal release cavity. The release cavities are the 2 center rows of cavities on one half of the connector. Page 5913 For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 1327 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. 4. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front of the connector. Page 785 Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Engine Control Module Replacement Service of the engine control module (ECM) should consist of either replacement of the ECM or programming of the electrically erasable programmable read only memory (EEPROM). If the diagnostic procedures call for the ECM to be replaced, the replacement ECM should be checked to ensure that the correct part is being used. If the correct part is being used, remove the faulty ECM and install the new service ECM. The replacement ECM must be programmed. Notice: * Turn the ignition OFF when installing or removing the control module connectors and disconnecting or reconnecting the power to the control module (battery cable, powertrain control module (PCM)/engine control module (ECM)/transaxle control module (TCM) pigtail, control module fuse, jumper cables, etc.) in order to prevent internal control module damage. * Control module damage may result when the metal case contacts battery voltage. DO NOT contact the control module metal case with battery voltage when servicing a control module, using battery booster cables, or when charging the vehicle battery. * In order to prevent any possible electrostatic discharge damage to the control module, do no touch the connector pins or the soldered components on the circuit board. * Remove any debris from around the control module connector surfaces before servicing the control module. Inspect the control module connector gaskets when diagnosing or replacing the control module. Ensure that the gaskets are installed correctly. The gaskets prevent contaminant intrusion into the control module. * The replacement control module must be programmed. Important: It is necessary to record the remaining engine oil life. If the replacement module is not programed with the remaining engine oil life, the engine oil life will default to 100 percent. If the replacement module is not programmed with the remaining engine oil life, the engine oil will need to be changed at 5 000 km (3,000 mi) from the last engine oil change. Removal Procedure 1. Using a scan tool, retrieve the percentage of remaining engine oil. Record the remaining engine oil life. 2. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 3. Disconnect the cooling fan electrical connector for additional clearance while removing the ECM. 4. Squeeze the ECM/transmission control module (TCM) cover upper retainers (1) in. 5. Remove the ECM/TCM cover. Page 2781 4. Position the tool J 41364-A onto the park/neutral position switch. Ensure that the 2 slots on the switch where the manual shaft is inserted are lined up with the lower 2 tabs on the tool. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 5. Rotate the tool until the upper locator pin on the tool is lined up with the slot on the top of the switch. Tighten the bolts securing the switch to 25 N.m (18 lb ft). 6. Remove the J 41364-A from the switch. If installing a new switch, remove the positive assurance bracket at this time. 7. Connect the electrical connectors to the switch. 8. Install the transmission control lever to the manual shaft with the nut. Tighten the control lever nut to 25 N.m (18 lb ft). 9. Lower the vehicle. 10. Check the switch for proper operation. The engine must start in the P (Park) or N (Neutral) positions only. If proper operation of the switch can not be obtained, replace the switch. Page 7535 7. Pressing the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool in the release cavity of the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and crimper in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (DOOR MODULE) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Side view of connector. View of top of connector. 1. Locate the assist lever and lock on the top of the connector. Page 8574 7. Pressing the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool in the release cavity of the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and crimper in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (DOOR MODULE) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Side view of connector. View of top of connector. 1. Locate the assist lever and lock on the top of the connector. Page 203 - Most Molex connectors will have the Molex logo on the dresscover of the connector. In some cases the connectors may have MX followed by another letter. The third letter indicates where the connector was made. A connector with MXD is a Molex connector made in Detroit. Sumitomo has a unique symbol on their connector and possibly a part number. The symbol is similar to that of a diamond lying on its side, similar to that shown. The logo could appear anywhere but the most common place is at the wire side of the housing. Tyco/AMP has many different and unique connector designs. Some may or may not have identifiable marks on them. Page 5451 Release the lower wiredress cover locking tab. Release the upper wiredress cover locking tab. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. Page 7638 2. Locate the nose piece locking tabs that are positioned on the side of the connector nose piece. The connector nose piece acts as a terminal positive assurance (TPA) and may be referred to as such. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to push in one of the locking tabs while gently pulling on the same side of the nose piece. 4. Repeat the procedure for the other locking tab and remove the nose piece. 5. Remove the wire dress cover. The following is a general procedure for wire dress cover removal. Use this procedure as a guide, some dress cover removal procedures may vary. 6. Use fingers to squeeze the 2 locking legs of the cover. Page 2944 Drive Belt: Service and Repair Drive Belt Replacement - Air Conditioning Drive Belt Replacement - Air Conditioning Removal Procedure 1. Remove the accessory drive belt. Refer to Drive Belt Replacement - Accessory. 2. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 3. Install a ratchet into the square opening of the air conditioning (A/C) belt tensioner. 4. Rotate the A/C belt tensioner clockwise in order to relieve tension on the belt. 5. Remove the A/C belt from the pulleys. 6. Slowly release the tension on the A/C belt tensioner. 7. Remove the ratchet from the A/C belt tensioner. 8. Clean and inspect the belt surfaces of all the pulleys. Installation Procedure 1. Install the A/C belt around the crankshaft balancer. 2. Install a ratchet into the square opening of the A/C drive belt tensioner. 3. Rotate the A/C belt tensioner clockwise in order to relieve tension on the belt. 4. Install the A/C belt over the idler pulley. 5. Install the A/C belt around the A/C compressor pulley. 6. Slowly release the tension on the A/C belt tensioner. 7. Remove the ratchet from the A/C belt tensioner. 8. Inspect the A/C belt for proper installation and alignment. 9. Lower the vehicle. 10. Install the accessory drive belt. Refer to Drive Belt Replacement - Accessory. Page 5748 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the DuraSeal splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of a connector. CPAs are used in all SIR System connectors and also in some connectors of other systems. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals of a connection. TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE CLIPS IMPORTANT: When making a splice in an area that may be exposed to moisture use a crimp and seal splice sleeve instead of a Splice Clip. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. Page 8472 1. Install the CKP sensor. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Install the CKP sensor bolt. Tighten the bolt to 25 N.m (18 lb ft). 3. Connect the electrical connector (2) to the CKP sensor (1). 4. Install the starter. Page 3352 vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide variety of actions, including: - Wiggling the harness - Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting - Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector - Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation - Relocating a harness or wires All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. Another option is, with the component commanded ON and OFF by the scan tool, move related connectors and wiring and observe the component operation. With the engine running, move related connectors and wiring while monitoring engine operation. If harness or connector movement affects the data displayed, component/system operation, or engine operation, inspect and repair the harness/connections as necessary. You may need to load the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these cases you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide good results as well. There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions, along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the circuit to these kinds of conditions. SALT WATER SPRAY Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture. Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5 percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously. HIGH TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070. Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault condition. The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis. This option does not allow for the same control, however. LOW TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect. If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to -18°C (0°F) from one end and +71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized cooling needs. Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or components in an effort to duplicate the concern. DUPLICATING FAILURE CONDITIONS - If none of the previous tests are successful, attempt to duplicate and/or capture the failure conditions. Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, where applicable, contains the conditions that were present when the DTC set. 1. Review and record Freeze Frame/Failure Records data. 2. Clear the DTCs using the scan tool. 3. Turn the key to OFF and wait 15 seconds. 4. Operate the vehicle under the same conditions that were noted in Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, as closely as possible. The vehicle must also be operating within the Conditions for Running the DTC. Refer to Conditions for Running the DTC in the supporting text if a DTC is being diagnosed. 5. Monitor DTC Status for the DTC being tested. The scan tool will indicate Ran, when the enabling conditions have been satisfied long enough for the DTC to run. The scan tool will also indicate whether the DTC passed or failed. - An alternate method is to drive the vehicle with the DMM connected to a suspected circuit. An abnormal reading on the DMM when the concern occurs, may help you locate the concern. Measuring Frequency Page 7816 4. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the rear of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. 5. Once the locking tabs are unlocked, slide the inner connector out of the rear of the connector housing. Page 8268 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert terminal into the appropriate terminal holder until it hits bottom and stops. The correct terminal holder is determined by the wire size. Also ensure that the terminals wings are pointing towards the former on the tool and the release locator. 5. Insert the stripped cable into the terminal. Insulation should be visible on both sides of the terminal insulation wings. 6. Compress the handles until the ratchet automatically releases. 7. Place the terminal into the appropriate cavity and assemble the connector. Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO-PACK 100W) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W connectors. These connectors are very similar but use different terminals and have some minor physical differences also. Page 2574 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. 4. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front of the connector. Locations Body Control Module (BCM) Page 5367 The engine harness may be repaired using the J-38125. High Temperature Wiring Repairs HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperatures, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time may use materials i.e. wires, connectors, and shielding that has a higher heat rating than typical wiring. When making a repair in a high temperature area observe the following: Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature to replace any damaged wire. - Replace any heat shielding that is removed. - Cover any DuraSeal splice sleeves with SCT1 shrink tubing (available in the J-38125 Terminal Repair kit). - After making a wiring repair, ensure that the location of the wiring is not moved closer to the heat source. IDENTIFYING HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperature, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time need special considerations when making wiring repairs. Areas that may be exposed to higher temperatures can be identified by heat resistant materials that are being used in those areas. These materials may include heat reflective tape, moon tape, and high temperature shrink tubing. Also conduit and other protective coverings may be used. Because conduit or similar coverings are used throughout the vehicle regardless of the temperature, it may be necessary for the technician to determine if an area is exposed to excessive heat before making a wiring repair. Obvious areas of consideration would be any area located near the exhaust manifolds, catalytic converter, and exhaust pipes. The J-38125 contains much of the material you will need to perform repairs on areas exposed to high heat. The kit contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves to crimp and seal connections - High temperature SCT1 shrink tubing to protect the splice sleeves - A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct crimp tool to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools to remove the terminals from the connectors The J-38125 does not contain wire that is suitable to high temperature exposure. Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature of the same or larger gage size as the original wire when repair damage wire. Also replace any reflective tape that you remove during the repair. HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature rating of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125 and then encapsulate the splice sleeve using the high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the order listed. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip keeping all of the wire strands intact. Page 7840 6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias. Reference the appropriate service manual wiring schematic to obtain the correct diode installation position. 7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for the soldering equipment. 8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed. 9. IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode attachment points with tape. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape. Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable SPLICING TWISTED OR SHIELDED CABLE Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable. 1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splice is made. 3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire. Staggering the splices by 65 mm (2.5 in) is recommended. 4. IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical contact with the drain wire. Re-assemble the cable. Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape. - Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1). - Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire. - Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape. Specifications Crankshaft Main Bearing: Specifications Crankshaft Bearing Cap M10 Bolts First Pass in Sequence ........................................................................................................................ ..................................................... 20 N.m (15 lb ft) Final Pass in Sequence ...................................... ................................................................................................................................................ 80 degrees Crankshaft Bearing Cap M10 Studs First Pass in Sequence ........................................................................................................................ ..................................................... 20 N.m (15 lb ft) Final Pass in Sequence ...................................... ................................................................................................................................................ 51 degrees Crankshaft Bearing Cap M8 Bolts .............................................................................................................................................................. 25 N.m (18 lb ft) Block Crankshaft Main Bearing Bore Diameter .................................................................................................................... 69.871-69.889 mm (2.75-2.751 in) Crankshaft Main Bearing Bore Out-of-Round ................................................................................................................................. 0.006 mm (0.0002 in) Crankshaft Main Bearing Clearance Production ............................................................................................................................................................. 0.02-0.052 mm (0.0008-0.0021 in) Service ......................................................................................... ......................................................................... 0.02-0.065 mm (0.0008-0.0025 in) Page 851 7. Apply pressure and gently rock the cover until one locking leg is unseated. 8. Continue to apply pressure and rock the cover until the second locking leg is unseated. Repeat procedure for the other side of the dress cover and remove the cover. 9. Use J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) to gently lift the terminal retaining tab while gently pulling the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 10. If the terminal is severely bent or damaged, it may be possible on some connectors to push the wire out of the front of the connector instead of Page 1988 - Kostel - Molex - Sumitomo - Tyco/AMP - Yazaki Identifying the manufacturer of a connector is often difficult. When trying to determine the manufacturer of a connector, look for specific identifying marks that are unique to that connector supplier. Most of these identify marks are hard to find or see. Check the connector carefully and refer to the information below for pictures and descriptions of connector identification markings. - Most of AFLs connectors have EPC on their connector body. Some of the smaller connectors will not have any markings on them. - In some cases Bosch will actually be printed on the connector. If Bosch does not appear on the connector, look for the Bosch logo. The Bosch logo is a circle with a blunted arrow inside. This logo can appear anywhere on the connector and is often very small. Page 1804 Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Service and Repair Manifold Absolute Pressure Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Disconnect the manifold absolute pressure (MAP) sensor electrical connector (3). 2. Remove the MAP sensor retaining clip (2) from the intake manifold. 3. Remove the MAP sensor (1) from the intake manifold. Installation Procedure Important: Lightly coat the MAP sensor seal with clean engine oil before installing the sensor. Page 6884 Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. For connectors with a bolt in the dress cover, turn the bolt counterclockwise to remove the connector from the component. 2. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. Page 1712 View of connector in released position. 4. Disconnect the connector from the component. 5. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Release the rear lower half of the wiredress cover. Page 6376 breakers are used. CIRCUIT BREAKER This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high current is removed. POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) CIRCUIT BREAKER This type greatly increases its resistance when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker will re-close within a second or 2. Circuit Protection - Fuses CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSES The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and examine the element in the fuse for an open (2). If not broken (1), also check for continuity using a DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one of equal current rating. Circuit Protection - Fusible Links CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSIBLE LINKS Page 6005 3. Ensure that the terminal release tang access panel is in the correct location to access the terminals. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) into the terminal release tang access slot located behind the access panel of the connector and press down on the terminal while carefully pulling the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Tyco/AMP Connectors (0.25 Cap) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (025 CAP) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component by pressing down on the connector position assurance (CPA). Page 5857 3. Remove the dress cover by using a flat-blade tool to release the connector locking tabs and pulling off the dress cover. 4. Relieve the tension on the nose piece retainers by inserting J-38125-12A (12094429) into the single retainer slot on the end of the nose piece and gently prying out the locking tab. Repeat the process for both of the nose piece locking tabs on the opposite side of the nose piece. Page 4893 If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200 DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J 39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected. IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J 39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and maximum (MAX) values measured. 1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of a suspected circuit to the other. 2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J 39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep). IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value in order to record the full change. 5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling the connections or the wiring, test driving, or performing other operations. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions. 6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9. Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist. Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections TESTING FOR INTERMITTENT CONDITIONS AND POOR CONNECTIONS TOOLS REQUIRED - J 35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit - J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit When the condition is not currently present, but is indicated in DTC history, the cause may be intermittent. An intermittent may also be the cause when there is a customer complaint, but the symptom cannot be duplicated. Refer to the Symptom Table of the system that is suspect of causing the condition before trying to locate an intermittent condition. Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the following items: Wiring broken inside the insulation - Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector - Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself, and corrosion in the wire to terminal contact area, etc. - Pierced or damaged insulation can allow moisture to enter the wiring causing corrosion. The conductor can corrode inside the insulation, with little visible evidence. Look for swollen and stiff sections of wire in the suspect circuits. - Wiring which has been pinched, cut, or its insulation rubbed through may cause an intermittent open or short as the bare area touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle. - Wiring that comes in contact with hot or exhaust components - Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required, in order to verify the customer concern. - Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. - Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis and Vehicle Data Recorder operation. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any inline connectors before replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation. Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination, usually in the underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit. Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper adapter. Always use the J 35616 when probing connectors. Other causes of terminal deformation are improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT IN BUSSED ELECTRICAL CENTERS (BEC) Page 900 If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the DuraSeal splice sleeves. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: - Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. - Do not use the crimp and DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 to crimp DuraSeal splice sleeve. In order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 7092 Open the harness by removing any tape. 2. Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. 3. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 4. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent american wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 5. Slide a section of high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing down the length of wire to be spliced. Ensure that the shrink tubing will not interfere with the splice procedure. 6. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 7. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. 8. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 9. Insert the wire into the DuraSeal splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 10. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Page 740 7. The illustration above identifies the entry canal where the terminal release tool will be inserted, and the terminal cavity. - Terminal (1) - Entry Canal (2) 8. Insert the J-38125-553 (15315247) tool into the entry canal and pry up on the terminal retainer. The terminal retainer is a small plastic piece on the top of the terminal. The terminal retainer must be held up while the terminal is pulled out of the connector. Page 285 Memory Seat Module - Driver C3 (w/Memory) Page 5730 3. Ensure that the terminal release tang access panel is in the correct location to access the terminals. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) into the terminal release tang access slot located behind the access panel of the connector and press down on the terminal while carefully pulling the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Tyco/AMP Connectors (0.25 Cap) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (025 CAP) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component by pressing down on the connector position assurance (CPA). Page 284 Memory Positioning Module: Diagrams Memory Seat Module - Driver C3 Memory Seat Module - Driver C2 (w/Memory) Page 3460 Fuse Block - Underhood C1 (5.3L/6.0L) Page 5603 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Start in the middle and gradually move the heat barrel to the open ends of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Heated Oxygen Sensor Wiring Repairs HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being obstructed. If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. - Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks, etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire. - Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance. - To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector. Page 4407 Release the lower wiredress cover locking tab. Release the upper wiredress cover locking tab. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. Page 2828 Rear Window Wiper/Washer Switch Page 6461 View of typical connector. View of connector in released position. 1. Locate the assist lever at the back of the connector. Move the assist lever to the rear position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the dress cover. Page 1772 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert a small flat-blade tool in the slot below the front loaded terminal position assurance (TPA) and pry up. 3. Remove the TPA by pulling it out of the connector. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-553 (GM P/N 15315247) on a slight upward angle into the cavity below the terminal to be removed. Ensure that the pointed on the end of the tool is facing the bottom of the terminal and it stays in contact with the terminal until it stops on the plastic terminal retainer. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 1606 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the TPA. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the nose piece. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. OnStar(R) - Negative Impact of Cloth/Vinyl Roofs Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Negative Impact of Cloth/Vinyl Roofs INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 02-08-44-007D Date: May 12, 2009 Subject: Negative Impact of Dealer-Installed Cloth/Vinyl Roofs on XM Radio and/or OnStar(R) Systems Models: 2002-2009 Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2003-2009 HUMMER H2 2006-2009 HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X with XM Radio (RPO U2K) and/or OnStar(R) (RPO UE1) .............................................................................................................................................................. .................................................................................. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to include the 2009 model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 02-08-44-007C (Section 08 - Body and Accessories). .............................................................................................................................................................. .................................................................................. Dealers should not install a cloth or vinyl roof on vehicles that have been ordered with the XM radio option (RPO U2K) and/or OnStar(R) (RPO UE1). The performance of these systems may be negatively impacted by the installation of the cloth/vinyl roof. Additionally, water leaks may result from installing a cloth or vinyl roof on vehicles with roof-mounted antenna systems. Relocating the antenna to another spot on the vehicle exterior, in order to install a cloth or vinyl roof, is not advised either. The performance of the OnStar(R) and XM Radio antennas has been optimized for their current locations. Relocating the antennas may result in a performance degradation. Disclaimer Page 209 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert terminal into the appropriate terminal holder until it hits bottom and stops. The correct terminal holder is determined by the wire size. Also ensure that the terminals wings are pointing towards the former on the tool and the release locator. 5. Insert the stripped cable into the terminal. Insulation should be visible on both sides of the terminal insulation wings. 6. Compress the handles until the ratchet automatically releases. 7. Place the terminal into the appropriate cavity and assemble the connector. Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO-PACK 100W) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W connectors. These connectors are very similar but use different terminals and have some minor physical differences also. Page 1012 Steering Wheel Control Switch Assembly - Upper Left (STW) Steering Wheel Control Switch Assembly - Upper Right (STW) Page 4826 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Kostal Connectors KOSTAL CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 3393 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the TPA. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the nose piece. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. Page 5441 4. Once the front 2 locks are unlocked, lift the front of the dress cover and pull it forward. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the small slot on the TPA and pushing down until the TPA releases. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to angle or rock the J 38125-21 tool when inserting it into the connector or the tool may break. Insert the J 38125-21 (GM P/N 15381651-2) tool into the round canal between the terminals cavities at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to repair Micro 64 connector terminals. The Micro 64 connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-64 (M jaw) was developed to crimp Micro 64 terminals. The J 38125-64 crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. The J 38125-64 crimping tool is also designed to crimp both the wire and the insulation at the same time. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro 64 terminals. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. 1. Cut the wire as close to the damaged terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. Page 4471 All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system. Page 2008 Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. FCI Connectors FCI CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 1402 US English/Metric Conversion US English/Metric Conversion Page 5199 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully raise the TPA on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA cannot be removed from the connector while there are terminals present in the connector body. View of the TPA when removed from the connector body. 4. Use the J 38125-12A tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the left side of the terminal release cavity as shown in the graphic. Use the tool to move the terminal release to the right with a gentle prying motion. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 1704 Refer to the following table as a guide in selecting the correct test adapter for front probing connectors: Backprobe IMPORTANT: Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures. - Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector. - Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large of a test probe. - After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected, test for proper terminal contact. Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the connector. Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure SCAN TOOL SNAPSHOT PROCEDURE Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used Page 6583 5. Once the nose piece retainers are relaxed, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should raise slightly. 6. On the opposite side of the nose piece, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should release completely. If the nose piece does not come off, repeat the procedure on the opposite side. Page 5146 Utility/Van Zoning UTILITY/VAN ZONING Page 4658 6. Gently pry the plastic terminal retainer down and carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (16-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, pull the two connector halves apart. Page 3264 Depress the locks that are located on both sides of the wiredress cover and pull the lever over and past the locks. View of the connector when released from the component. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the front of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool push down on one of the locking tabs and pull the cover up until the dress cover releases. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. Page 6990 5. Engage the sliding latch fastening the BCM to the rear electrical center. Slide the latch outboard until the locking tab (1) is fully seated. 6. Install the rear electrical center cover. 7. If replacing the body wiring harness extension on a Chevrolet TrailBlazer or GMC Envoy, position the left hand second seat to a passenger position. 8. If replacing the body wiring harness extension on a Chevrolet TrailBlazer EXT or GMC Envoy XL, install the left second row seat. 9. Connect the negative battery cable. Page 6572 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully raise the TPA on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA cannot be removed from the connector while there are terminals present in the connector body. View of the TPA when removed from the connector body. 4. Use the J 38125-12A tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the left side of the terminal release cavity as shown in the graphic. Use the tool to move the terminal release to the right with a gentle prying motion. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 7342 difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Bosch Connectors (ECM) BOSCH CONNECTORS (ECM) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the assist lever on the top of the connector. Move the assist lever to the forward position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 1438 Release the tabs that are holding the wiredress cover to the connector body. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the slots on both ends of the connector body. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. J 38125-216 can also be used to remove the nose piece. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by lifting the terminal retaining tabs on the inside of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 5420 Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. For connectors with a bolt in the dress cover, turn the bolt counterclockwise to remove the connector from the component. 2. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. Page 8007 - Kostel - Molex - Sumitomo - Tyco/AMP - Yazaki Identifying the manufacturer of a connector is often difficult. When trying to determine the manufacturer of a connector, look for specific identifying marks that are unique to that connector supplier. Most of these identify marks are hard to find or see. Check the connector carefully and refer to the information below for pictures and descriptions of connector identification markings. - Most of AFLs connectors have EPC on their connector body. Some of the smaller connectors will not have any markings on them. - In some cases Bosch will actually be printed on the connector. If Bosch does not appear on the connector, look for the Bosch logo. The Bosch logo is a circle with a blunted arrow inside. This logo can appear anywhere on the connector and is often very small. Page 8647 Oxygen Sensor: Diagnostic Aids Arrows and Symbols Arrows and Symbols This Service Data uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations. Arrows and Symbols 1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow Basic Knowledge Required GENERAL ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures contained in the service manual. You should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current (amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram, as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. Decimal and Metric Equivalents Decimal and Metric Equivalents Page 7467 Utility/Van Zoning UTILITY/VAN ZONING Page 1926 11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the solder equipment. 12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. 13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to cover the first piece of tape. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE SLEEVES TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit IMPORTANT: Use only dura seal splice sleeves. Other splice sleeves may not protect the splice from moisture or provide a good electrical connection. Use duraseal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. Use duraseal splice sleeves where there is special requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire using duraseal splice sleeves. Page 6274 11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the solder equipment. 12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. 13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to cover the first piece of tape. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE SLEEVES TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit IMPORTANT: Use only dura seal splice sleeves. Other splice sleeves may not protect the splice from moisture or provide a good electrical connection. Use duraseal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. Use duraseal splice sleeves where there is special requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire using duraseal splice sleeves. Page 2314 MEASURING FREQUENCY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal. IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM to autorange to an appropriate range. 1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency measured. Measuring Voltage MEASURING VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit. 1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods: - Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. - Turn ON the engine. - Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls. - Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested. 3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The DMM displays the voltage measured at that point. Measuring Voltage Drop MEASURING VOLTAGE DROP NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points. Probing Electrical Connectors PROBING ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS Page 9027 5. Insert the J 38125-557 (GM P/N 12122378) into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 6. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Connector Position Assurance Locks CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of the connector. CPAs are used in various connectors throughout the vehicle. CPAs are also used in all SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals, of the connector. Connector Repairs CONNECTOR REPAIRS Page 469 IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals. Front probe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the connector. IMPORTANT: When probing female 0.64 terminals, it is important to use the correct adapter. There have been some revisions to the test adapter for 0.64 terminals. The proper adapter for 0.64 terminals is the J 35616-64B which has a gold terminal and a black wire between the base and tip. Failure to use the proper test adapter may result in damage to the terminal being tested and improper diagnosis. NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Page 4666 Open the harness by removing any tape. 2. Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. 3. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 4. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent american wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 5. Slide a section of high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing down the length of wire to be spliced. Ensure that the shrink tubing will not interfere with the splice procedure. 6. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 7. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. 8. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 9. Insert the wire into the DuraSeal splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 10. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Page 1670 Important: Never reuse the old seal or a fuel leak may occur. Always use a NEW seal. 1. Install a NEW seal (3) onto the fuel tank. Important: Place the fuel pump strainer in a horizontal position when you install the fuel sender in the tank. When installing the fuel sender assembly, assure that the fuel pump strainer does not block full travel of the float arm. 2. Install the fuel sender assembly (2). Important: Always replace the fuel sender seal when installing the fuel sender assembly. Replace the lock ring if necessary. Do not apply any type of lubrication in the seal groove. Ensure the lock ring is installed with the correct side facing upward. A correctly installed lock ring will only turn in a clockwise direction. 3. Use the J45722 in order to install the fuel sender lock ring. Turn the fuel sender lock ring in a clockwise direction. Page 2994 Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair Fuel Pressure Gage Installation and Removal Fuel Pressure Gage Installation and Removal Tools Required CH-48027 Digital Pressure Gage Installation Procedure Caution: Refer to Gasoline/Gasoline Vapors Caution. Caution: Remove the fuel tank cap and relieve the fuel system pressure before servicing the fuel system in order to reduce the risk of personal injury. After you relieve the fuel system pressure, a small amount of fuel may be released when servicing the fuel lines, the fuel injection pump, or the connections. In order to reduce the risk of personal injury, cover the fuel system components with a shop towel before disconnection. This will catch any fuel that may leak out. Place the towel in an approved container when the disconnection is complete. 1. Relieve the fuel system pressure. Refer to Fuel Pressure Relief. 2. Connect the CH-48027-1 (1) to the CH-48027-2 (2). 3. Remove the shop towel from around the fuel rail service port, and place in an approved gasoline container. 4. Perform any tests and/or diagnostics as needed. For the proper usage of the CH-48027 , refer to the manufacture's directions. Removal Procedure Page 7662 3. Remove the dress cover by using a flat-blade tool to release the connector locking tabs and pulling off the dress cover. 4. Relieve the tension on the nose piece retainers by inserting J-38125-12A (12094429) into the single retainer slot on the end of the nose piece and gently prying out the locking tab. Repeat the process for both of the nose piece locking tabs on the opposite side of the nose piece. Page 6044 1. If reinstalling the old sensor, coat the threads with anti-seize compound GM P/N 12377953, or equivalent. Notice: Refer to Component Fastener Tightening Notice. 2. Install the HO2S (2). Tighten the sensor to 42 N.m (31 lb ft). 3. Connect the HO2S electrical connector. 4. Install the CPA retainer. 5. Lower the vehicle. Page 4618 The first connector design of the Micro-Pack 100W (1) has a white connector interface that holds the terminals. The second design of the Micro-Pack 100W (2) has a gray interface to hold the terminals. Also, the first design has terminal cavities that are further apart (3 mm centerline) and offset from the other row of terminal cavities in the connector. The second design has terminals cavities that are closer together (2.54 mm centerline) and aligned vertically. One other way to identify the second design is the thin strip of material that runs along the outside of the cavities. IMPORTANT: There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W terminals which are very similar. Ensure that you have the correct terminal before crimping the new terminal to the wire. The first design connector uses the longer terminal (1) that has a raised area in front of the recess in the terminal. The second design connector uses the shorter terminal without the raised area. Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro-Pack 100W connectors. Some Micro-Pack 100W connector disassembly procedures will vary. Use this procedure as a guide. 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 5862 7. Pressing the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool in the release cavity of the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and crimper in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (DOOR MODULE) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Side view of connector. View of top of connector. 1. Locate the assist lever and lock on the top of the connector. Page 694 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (BSK) BOSCH CONNECTORS (BSK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 3. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 4. Insert the J 38125-561 tool into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 5. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is Page 8200 If a wire is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm, etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except coaxial. - Do not use the DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent American wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 6057 Page 737 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 7158 - A control module from another vehicle is installed. - Revised software/calibration files have been released for this vehicle. - IMPORTANT: DO NOT re-program the control module with the SAME software/calibration files that are already present in the control module. This is not an effective repair for any type of concern. Verify that the control module contains the correct software/calibration. If incorrect programming is found, reprogram the control module with the most current software/calibration. Refer to Control Module References for replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Testing for Short to Ground TESTING FOR SHORT TO GROUND NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 4. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit. With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is a short to ground in the circuit. Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2. Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). - When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. - If the DMM does not display voltage 4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is shorted. Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A DIGITAL MULTIMETER NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the powertrain control module (PCM), should only be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200 Digital Multimeter (DMM). The J 39200 instruction manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminage even though voltage is present. The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity. IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading. Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the measurement. Page 4624 The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors. 1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position. 4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool J 38125-10A (GM P/N 12014012-1) into the front (mating end) of the connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal through the back of the connector (2). IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector. 6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. 7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily. 10. Perform system check. Delphi Connectors (12 Way) DELPHI CONNECTORS (12-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. Page 8932 Release the lower wiredress cover locking tab. Release the upper wiredress cover locking tab. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. Page 5606 11. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 12. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 13. Center the high temperature SCT1 shrink tube over the DuraSeal splice sleeve. 14. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the high temperature heat shrink tubing. 15. Gradually move the heat from the center to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 16. Replace any reflective tape and clips that may have been remove during the repair. Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation REPAIRING DAMAGED WIRE INSULATION Wire Size Conversion Page 5684 5. Insert the J 38125-557 (GM P/N 12122378) into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 6. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Connector Position Assurance Locks CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of the connector. CPAs are used in various connectors throughout the vehicle. CPAs are also used in all SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals, of the connector. Connector Repairs CONNECTOR REPAIRS Page 7070 5. Once the nose piece retainers are relaxed, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should raise slightly. 6. On the opposite side of the nose piece, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should release completely. If the nose piece does not come off, repeat the procedure on the opposite side. Cooling System - Inspecting Radiator/Heater Hose Clamps Heater Hose: Technical Service Bulletins Cooling System - Inspecting Radiator/Heater Hose Clamps INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 06-06-02-014B Date: June 13, 2008 Subject: Inspecting Radiator and Heater Hose Clamps and Seals for Leaks During Pre-Delivery Inspection (PDI) Models: 2007 Buick Rainier 2007-2009 Chevrolet TrailBlazer, TrailBlazer SS 2007-2009 GMC Envoy 2007-2009 Saab 9-7X Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2009 model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 06-06-02-014A (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). The purpose of this bulletin is to inform dealers of required inspection of underhood and under vehicle radiator and heater hose clamps and seals for leaks and/or seepage during pre-delivery inspection (PDI). Field feedback indicates that some customers may notice engine coolant leaks shortly after delivery, which may result in an immediate decline of customer satisfaction with their new vehicle purchase. When performing a PDI on a vehicle listed in the models affected above, pay specific attention to the effectiveness of the engine coolant hose seal locations. Reposition/reclamp or replace the clamp to effect a proper system seal prior to customer delivery. Locations to Inspect During PDI Dealership personnel should examine the following locations closely during PDI (4.2L LL8 application shown in graphics below; refer to SI for specific information on 5.3L LH6 and 6.0L LS2):L LH6 and 6.0L LS2): 1. Radiator inlet hose (upper hose) to radiator (1). 2. Radiator inlet hose (upper hose) to engine (2). Page 8178 8. Insert the J 38125-213 into the small terminal release hole on the nose piece and gently pull on the back of the wire. 9. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Repairing Connector Terminals REPAIRING CONNECTOR TERMINALS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following: Push to Seat terminals - Pull to Seat terminals Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your terminal repair. The J-38125 contains further information. 1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.For cable seal terminals, remove the seal. 2. Apply the correct cable seal per gage size of the wire, if used.Slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation removal. 3. Remove the insulation. 4. For sealed terminals only, align the seal with the end of the cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal.For sealed terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal. 6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.For sealed terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable. 8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals excepting Micro-Pack 100.64 size. Soldering Micro-Pack 100 World terminals may damage the terminal. Sumitomo Connectors SUMITOMO CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 8486 Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Diagrams Engine Controls Connector End Views Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor Page 943 Air Bag Control Module: Locations SIR Component Views Inflatable Restraint Sensing and Diagnostic Module (SDM) 1 - Lower Console 2 - Inflatable Restraint Sensing and Diagnostic Module (SDM) Page 3908 20. Extract a portion of the ECT sensor harness wiring and connector from the protective conduit. Cut off the ECT sensor harness connector and wiring. 21. Determine a routing path for the ECT sensor jumper harness wires so that they can be secured TO or WITHIN an existing protective conduit. Note This step is to set up and verify the length of wiring that is required before cutting. 22. Route the ECT sensor jumper wires and then enclose them in their own protective conduit in order to VERIFY the length that is required. 23. Cut the ECT sensor jumper wires to the appropriate length. Note Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splice or connector. 24. Splice the ECT sensor jumper wires to the ORIGINAL ECT HARNESS LOCATION using DuraSeal weatherproof splices. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves in SI. Note Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splice or connector. 25. Splice the ECT sensor jumper wires to the ECT SENSOR HARNESS CONNECTOR using DuraSeal weatherproof splices. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves in SI. 26. Connect the ECT sensor harness connector to the ECT sensor. 27. Secure the ECT sensor jumper wires that are in their own protective conduit TO or WITHIN the existing harness conduit using tie straps. Important You MUST run the engine at the specified RPM and until it reaches normal operating temperature and then allow it to idle as indicated in SI. The engine MUST then be allowed to cool down in order to top off the coolant level as needed. 28. Fill the cooling system to the proper level. Refer to Cooling System Draining and Filling in SI. 29. Pressure test the cooling system. Refer to Cooling System Leak Testing in SI. 30. Use a scan tool to clear any DTCs. Relocating the Engine Coolant Heater Cord Important For reference, the procedure and graphics that are shown are from a Chevrolet Silverado, but are similar for the other vehicles listed above. 1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Ask the customer where they would prefer the extension cord to exit from the engine compartment in order to determine the required extension cord length. 3. Obtain an extension cord with the following features: - 120 volt - 14/3 gauge - 15A capacity - Three prong - Polarized plug and receptacle - Chemical resistant - Grounded terminals - Designed for use in a cold outdoor environment - Outer jacket resistant to deterioration from moisture, abrasion and exposure to sunlight - Maximum length of 2.5-3 m (8-10 ft) 4. Release enough of the clips that retain the engine coolant heater cord to the vehicle to provide the necessary length for repositioning. 5. Apply dielectric grease to the electrical contacts of the heater cord receptacle and the extension cord plug to prevent corrosion. Use GM P/N 12345579 (in Canada, use P/N 10953481) or an equivalent. 6. Connect the heater cord receptacle to the extension cord plug and wipe OFF any excess grease. Page 3999 Step 1 - Step 6 Page 2672 7. Position the sensor assembly above the front bumper. 8. Remove the retaining bolts and protective cover (1) from the sensor. 9. Remove the connector-position assurance (CPA) from the sensor electrical connector. 10. Disconnect the sensor (2) electrical connector. 11. Remove the sensor from the vehicle. Installation Procedure 1. Remove any dirt, grease, or other impurities from the mounting surface. 2. Position the sensor assembly horizontally above the front bumper. 3. Connect the sensor (2) electrical connector. 4. Install the connector-position assurance (CPA) to the sensor electrical connector. 5. Install the retaining bolts and protective cover (1) to the sensor. 6. Position the sensor assembly horizontally to the frame (1). 7. Point the arrow on the sensor toward the front of the vehicle. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 8. Install the 2 bolts (1) retaining the discriminating sensor assembly to the frame. Tighten the bolts to 8 N.m (71 lb in). Page 1465 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) and slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. Page 5283 All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system. Page 4801 - In some cases Delphi will actually be printed on the connector. If Delphi is not printed on the connector, look for PED. In both cases there is no specific orientation for Delphi or PED and they can appear anywhere on the connector. - FCI connectors may have the FCI logo on their connectors. The logo is the letters FCI with an "A" above it. - JAE connector have JAE in small letters on their connectors. Page 6842 Spark Plug: Application and ID Spark Plug Type.............................................................................................................................................GM P/N 12571164 AC Spark Plug P/N 41-985 Page 7982 Page 1475 View of typical connector. View of connector in released position. 1. Locate the assist lever at the back of the connector. Move the assist lever to the rear position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the dress cover. Page 7177 - Yazaki has a wedge or arrow shape, similar to that shown. Delphi Connectors (Micro .64) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro 64 connectors. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. The lever lock may be located on the top or sides of the wire dress cover. Page 4693 20. Extract a portion of the ECT sensor harness wiring and connector from the protective conduit. Cut off the ECT sensor harness connector and wiring. 21. Determine a routing path for the ECT sensor jumper harness wires so that they can be secured TO or WITHIN an existing protective conduit. Note This step is to set up and verify the length of wiring that is required before cutting. 22. Route the ECT sensor jumper wires and then enclose them in their own protective conduit in order to VERIFY the length that is required. 23. Cut the ECT sensor jumper wires to the appropriate length. Note Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splice or connector. 24. Splice the ECT sensor jumper wires to the ORIGINAL ECT HARNESS LOCATION using DuraSeal weatherproof splices. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves in SI. Note Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splice or connector. 25. Splice the ECT sensor jumper wires to the ECT SENSOR HARNESS CONNECTOR using DuraSeal weatherproof splices. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves in SI. 26. Connect the ECT sensor harness connector to the ECT sensor. 27. Secure the ECT sensor jumper wires that are in their own protective conduit TO or WITHIN the existing harness conduit using tie straps. Important You MUST run the engine at the specified RPM and until it reaches normal operating temperature and then allow it to idle as indicated in SI. The engine MUST then be allowed to cool down in order to top off the coolant level as needed. 28. Fill the cooling system to the proper level. Refer to Cooling System Draining and Filling in SI. 29. Pressure test the cooling system. Refer to Cooling System Leak Testing in SI. 30. Use a scan tool to clear any DTCs. Relocating the Engine Coolant Heater Cord Important For reference, the procedure and graphics that are shown are from a Chevrolet Silverado, but are similar for the other vehicles listed above. 1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Ask the customer where they would prefer the extension cord to exit from the engine compartment in order to determine the required extension cord length. 3. Obtain an extension cord with the following features: - 120 volt - 14/3 gauge - 15A capacity - Three prong - Polarized plug and receptacle - Chemical resistant - Grounded terminals - Designed for use in a cold outdoor environment - Outer jacket resistant to deterioration from moisture, abrasion and exposure to sunlight - Maximum length of 2.5-3 m (8-10 ft) 4. Release enough of the clips that retain the engine coolant heater cord to the vehicle to provide the necessary length for repositioning. 5. Apply dielectric grease to the electrical contacts of the heater cord receptacle and the extension cord plug to prevent corrosion. Use GM P/N 12345579 (in Canada, use P/N 10953481) or an equivalent. 6. Connect the heater cord receptacle to the extension cord plug and wipe OFF any excess grease. Page 2224 - Kostel - Molex - Sumitomo - Tyco/AMP - Yazaki Identifying the manufacturer of a connector is often difficult. When trying to determine the manufacturer of a connector, look for specific identifying marks that are unique to that connector supplier. Most of these identify marks are hard to find or see. Check the connector carefully and refer to the information below for pictures and descriptions of connector identification markings. - Most of AFLs connectors have EPC on their connector body. Some of the smaller connectors will not have any markings on them. - In some cases Bosch will actually be printed on the connector. If Bosch does not appear on the connector, look for the Bosch logo. The Bosch logo is a circle with a blunted arrow inside. This logo can appear anywhere on the connector and is often very small. Page 2616 3. Remove the dress cover by using a flat-blade tool to release the connector locking tabs and pulling off the dress cover. 4. Relieve the tension on the nose piece retainers by inserting J-38125-12A (12094429) into the single retainer slot on the end of the nose piece and gently prying out the locking tab. Repeat the process for both of the nose piece locking tabs on the opposite side of the nose piece. Page 5576 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the rear TPA from the connector. 7. IMPORTANT: The front TPA cannot be removed from the connector. Only move it to the release point. Use a small flat-blade tool to move the front TPA to the release position. 8. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 9. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Molex Connectors Page 4679 Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay: Service and Repair Cooling Fan Relay Replacement Tools Required J 43244 Relay Puller Pliers Removal Procedure 1. Remove the underhood electrical center cover. 2. Using the J 43244, remove the cooling fan relay (3). Installation Procedure Notice: Installation of the proper relay is critical. If an enhanced relay - equipped with a diode - is installed into a position requiring a standard relay - equipped without a diode - excessive current will damage any components associated with the relay or its associated circuits. 1. Install the cooling fan relay (3). 2. Install the underhood electrical center cover. Page 7697 Page 7041 Depress the locks that are located on both sides of the wiredress cover and pull the lever over and past the locks. View of the connector when released from the component. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the front of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool push down on one of the locking tabs and pull the cover up until the dress cover releases. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. Page 8122 Checking Aftermarket Accessories CHECKING AFTERMARKET ACCESSORIES Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits: - CAUTION: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol. - NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice. OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol. Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the cause of the problems. Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include: Power feeds connected to points other than the battery - Antenna location - Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring - Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line - Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories. Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions INDUCING INTERMITTENT FAULT CONDITIONS TOOLS REQUIRED J 25070 Heat Gun Many intermittent open or shorted circuits are affected by harness/connector movement that is caused by vibration, engine torque, bumps/rough pavement, etc. In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness if the malfunction appears to be Page 2274 6. Gently pry the plastic terminal retainer down and carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (16-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, pull the two connector halves apart. Page 671 Page 4844 3. Ensure that the terminal release tang access panel is in the correct location to access the terminals. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) into the terminal release tang access slot located behind the access panel of the connector and press down on the terminal while carefully pulling the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Tyco/AMP Connectors (0.25 Cap) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (025 CAP) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component by pressing down on the connector position assurance (CPA). Page 6614 5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape. Seat Belt Schematic Icons Seat Belt Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons Page 8740 5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape. Seat Belt Schematic Icons Seat Belt Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons Page 6411 Checking Aftermarket Accessories CHECKING AFTERMARKET ACCESSORIES Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits: - CAUTION: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol. - NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice. OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol. Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the cause of the problems. Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include: Power feeds connected to points other than the battery - Antenna location - Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring - Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line - Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories. Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions INDUCING INTERMITTENT FAULT CONDITIONS TOOLS REQUIRED J 25070 Heat Gun Many intermittent open or shorted circuits are affected by harness/connector movement that is caused by vibration, engine torque, bumps/rough pavement, etc. In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness if the malfunction appears to be Locations Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Locations HVAC Component Views Body Front End 1 - Ambient Air Temperature Sensor Page 3834 8. Inspect the camshaft sensor O-ring seal. If the O-ring seal is not cut or damaged, it may be reused. 9. Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil. 10. Install the camshaft sensor and bolt. Tighten the bolt to 25 N.m (18 lb ft). 11. Install the valve lifters. Refer to Valve Lifter Replacement. 12. Install the condenser. Refer to Condenser Replacement. Page 5562 TERMINAL REMOVAL Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors. 1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA) device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1). 3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 4. Gently pull the cable and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector. 5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal, refer to Terminal Repair. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3. Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector. REINSTALLING TERMINAL 1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly, refer to Wiring Repairs. 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3. Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) DELPHI CONNECTORS (WEATHER PACK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Drive Belt Replacement - Accessory Drive Belt: Service and Repair Drive Belt Replacement - Accessory Drive Belt Replacement - Accessory Removal Procedure 1. Remove the air cleaner resonator outlet duct. Refer to Air Cleaner Resonator Outlet Duct Replacement. 2. Install a breaker bar with hex-head socket to the drive belt tensioner bolt. 3. Rotate the drive belt tensioner clockwise in order to relieve tension on the belt. 4. Remove the belt from the generator pulley. 5. Slowly release the tension on the drive belt tensioner. 6. Remove the breaker bar and socket and from the drive belt tensioner bolt. 7. Remove the belt from the remaining pulleys. 8. Clean and inspect the belt surfaces of all the pulleys. Installation Procedure Page 6669 View of connector in released position. 4. Disconnect the connector from the component. 5. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Release the rear lower half of the wiredress cover. Page 695 difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Bosch Connectors (ECM) BOSCH CONNECTORS (ECM) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the assist lever on the top of the connector. Move the assist lever to the forward position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 2212 3. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. View showing depressing of the lever lock release tab. Page 8236 Checking Aftermarket Accessories CHECKING AFTERMARKET ACCESSORIES Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits: - CAUTION: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol. - NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice. OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol. Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the cause of the problems. Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include: Power feeds connected to points other than the battery - Antenna location - Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring - Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line - Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories. Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions INDUCING INTERMITTENT FAULT CONDITIONS TOOLS REQUIRED J 25070 Heat Gun Many intermittent open or shorted circuits are affected by harness/connector movement that is caused by vibration, engine torque, bumps/rough pavement, etc. In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness if the malfunction appears to be Page 4325 Cooling System Air Bleeder Pipe / Hose: Service and Repair Coolant Air Bleed Pipe Assembly Replacement Coolant Air Bleed Pipe Assembly Replacement (5.3L and 6.0L Engines) Removal Procedure 1. Drain the cooling system, if necessary. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System (LL8) Draining and Filling Cooling System (LH6, LS2). 2. Remove the air cleaner resonator outlet duct. Refer to Air Cleaner Resonator Outlet Duct Replacement or Air Cleaner Resonator Outlet Duct Replacement. 3. Reposition the coolant air bleed hose clamp at the coolant air bleed pipe. 4. Remove the coolant air bleed hose from the coolant air bleed pipe. 5. Remove the coolant air bleed pipe bolts (309). 6. Remove the coolant air bleed pipe (307) with seals (308). Page 3069 1. Install the inlet hose to the radiator. 2. Using J 38185 reposition the radiator inlet hose clamp to the radiator. 3. Install the inlet hose to the engine. 4. Using J 38185 reposition the radiator inlet hose clamp to the engine. 5. Install the air intake resonator. Refer to Air Cleaner Resonator Outlet Duct Replacement for the 5.3L engine or Air Cleaner Resonator Outlet Duct Replacement for the 6.0L engine. 6. Fill the cooling system. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System (LL8) Draining and Filling Cooling System (LH6, LS2). Specifications Timing Chain Tensioner: Specifications Timing Chain Tensioner Bolts ............................................................................................................. ....................................................... 25 N.m (15 lb ft) Page 4455 6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias. Reference the appropriate service manual wiring schematic to obtain the correct diode installation position. 7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for the soldering equipment. 8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed. 9. IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode attachment points with tape. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape. Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable SPLICING TWISTED OR SHIELDED CABLE Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable. 1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splice is made. 3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire. Staggering the splices by 65 mm (2.5 in) is recommended. 4. IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical contact with the drain wire. Re-assemble the cable. Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape. - Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1). - Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire. - Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape. Page 2636 If a wire is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm, etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except coaxial. - Do not use the DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent American wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 1681 1. Locate the air flow direction arrow (2) on the MAF/IAT sensor. 2. Install the MAF/IAT sensor on to the air cleaner housing. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 3. Tighten the clamp securing the MAF/IAT sensor to the air cleaner housing. Tighten the clamp to 7 N.m (62 lb in). 4. Install the air cleaner outlet duct. 5. Install the air cleaner outlet duct bolt. Tighten the bolt to 10 N.m (89 lb in). 6. Tighten the clamps at the MAF/IAT sensor and the throttle body. Tighten the clamps to 7 N.m (62 lb in). Page 6010 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert a small flat-blade tool in the slot below the front loaded terminal position assurance (TPA) and pry up. 3. Remove the TPA by pulling it out of the connector. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-553 (GM P/N 15315247) on a slight upward angle into the cavity below the terminal to be removed. Ensure that the pointed on the end of the tool is facing the bottom of the terminal and it stays in contact with the terminal until it stops on the plastic terminal retainer. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 7079 2. Use a small flat-bladed tool to release the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting the tool in the small recess on the side of the connector and pushing up until the TPA releases from the connector body. The TPA should raise just slightly. Do not try to remove the TPA. IMPORTANT: The TPA on this connector cannot be removed unless the terminals are removed first. The TPA will come out of the connector body, but only slightly. When the TPA is slightly raised the terminals can be removed. Using excessive force to remove the TPA with the terminals still in the connector will damage the connector. 3. Repeat the process for the other side of the connector. 4. Ensure that the TPA is in the proper position to remove the terminals. Page 2010 4. Use a small flat-blade tool to slide the terminal position assurance (TPA) up one notch on both ends of the connector. The TPA is located underneath the wire dress cover. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 8676 - Most Molex connectors will have the Molex logo on the dresscover of the connector. In some cases the connectors may have MX followed by another letter. The third letter indicates where the connector was made. A connector with MXD is a Molex connector made in Detroit. Sumitomo has a unique symbol on their connector and possibly a part number. The symbol is similar to that of a diamond lying on its side, similar to that shown. The logo could appear anywhere but the most common place is at the wire side of the housing. Tyco/AMP has many different and unique connector designs. Some may or may not have identifiable marks on them. Page 5433 - Kostel - Molex - Sumitomo - Tyco/AMP - Yazaki Identifying the manufacturer of a connector is often difficult. When trying to determine the manufacturer of a connector, look for specific identifying marks that are unique to that connector supplier. Most of these identify marks are hard to find or see. Check the connector carefully and refer to the information below for pictures and descriptions of connector identification markings. - Most of AFLs connectors have EPC on their connector body. Some of the smaller connectors will not have any markings on them. - In some cases Bosch will actually be printed on the connector. If Bosch does not appear on the connector, look for the Bosch logo. The Bosch logo is a circle with a blunted arrow inside. This logo can appear anywhere on the connector and is often very small. Page 1707 It is very important to use the correct test adapter when testing for proper terminal contact of fuses and relays in a bussed electrical center (BEC). Use J-35616-35 to test for proper terminal contact. Failure to use J-35616-35 can result in improper diagnosis of the BEC. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Separate the connector halves. 2. Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body. 3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J-38125 , test that the retention force is significantly different between a good terminal and a suspect terminal. Replace the female terminal in question. FLAT WIRE (DOCK AND LOCK) CONNECTORS There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock) connectors on the harness side or the component side. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Remove the component in question. 2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side of the connector as oil from your skin may be a source of contamination as well. 3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other imperfections that could cause poor terminal contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are uniform and free of damage or deformation. 4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the on the flat wire harness connector in order to test the circuit in question. CONTROL MODULE/COMPONENT VOLTAGE AND GROUNDS Poor voltage or ground connections can cause widely varying symptoms. Test all control module voltage supply circuits. Many vehicles have multiple circuits supplying voltage to a control module. Other components in the system may have separate voltage supply circuits that may also need to be tested. Inspect connections at the module/component connectors, fuses, and any intermediate connections between the voltage source and the module/component. A test lamp or a DMM may indicate that voltage is present, but neither tests the ability of the circuit to carry sufficient current. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Power Distribution Schematics. - Test all control module ground and system ground circuits. The control module may have multiple ground circuits. Other components in the system may have separate grounds that may also need to be tested. Inspect grounds for clean and tight connections at the grounding point. Inspect the connections at the component and in splice packs, where applicable. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Ground Distribution Schematics. TEMPERATURE SENSITIVITY - An intermittent condition may occur when a component/connection reaches normal operating temperature. The condition may occur only when the component/connection is cold, or only when the component/connection is hot. - Freeze Frame, Failure Records, Snapshot, or Vehicle Data Recorder data may help with this type of intermittent condition, where applicable. - If the intermittent is related to heat, review the data for a relationship with the following: High ambient temperatures - Underhood/engine generated heat - Circuit generated heat due to a poor connection, or high electrical load - Higher than normal load conditions, towing, etc. - If the intermittent is related to cold, review the data for the following: Low ambient temperatures-In extremely low temperatures, ice may form in a connection or component. Inspect for water intrusion. - The condition only occurs on a cold start. - The condition goes away when the vehicle warms up. - Information from the customer may help to determine if the trouble follows a pattern that is temperature related. - If temperature is suspected of causing an intermittent fault condition, attempt to duplicate the condition. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required. ELECTROMAGNETIC INTERFERENCE (EMI) AND ELECTRICAL NOISE Some electrical components/circuits are sensitive to electromagnetic interference (EMI) or other types of electrical noise. Inspect for the following conditions: A misrouted harness that is too close to high voltage/high current devices such as secondary ignition components, motors, generator etc-These components may induce electrical noise on a circuit that could interfere with normal circuit operation. - Electrical system interference caused by a malfunctioning relay, or a control module driven solenoid or switch-These conditions can cause a sharp electrical surge. Normally, the condition will occur when the malfunctioning component is operating. - Improper installation of non-factory or aftermarket add on accessories such as lights, 2-way radios, amplifiers, electric motors, remote starters, alarm systems, cell phones, etc-These accessories may lead to interference while in use, but do not fail when the accessories are not in use. - Test for an open diode across the A/C compressor clutch and for other open diodes. Some relays may contain a clamping diode. - The generator may be allowing AC noise into the electrical system. INCORRECT CONTROL MODULE - There are only a few situations where reprogramming a control module is appropriate: A new service control module is installed. Page 5529 to analyze the data during the time a vehicle condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a trigger point that you have determined. Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2 snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a first-in, first-out basis. If a third snapshot is taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost. Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types: Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice - Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200 frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not lost if the Scan Tool is powered down. The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis. The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected values by plotting 3 parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful, especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC. Testing for a Short to Voltage TESTING FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4. Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt, there is a short to voltage in the circuit. Testing for Continuity TESTING FOR CONTINUITY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6. Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit. 7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity. With a Test Lamp IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits. 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6. If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity. Testing for Electrical Intermittents TESTING FOR ELECTRICAL INTERMITTENTS Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment. - Testing for Short to Ground - Testing for Continuity - Testing for a Short to Voltage Page 7646 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the TPA. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the nose piece. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. Page 8953 3. Use a small flat-bladed tool to gently pry off the dress cover by inserting the tool under the cover opposite the harness side and prying up. 4. Remove the cover. 5. Using a small flat-bladed tool, push on the side of the nose piece retainer while pushing the nose piece forward with your thumb. This will release the terminal position assurance (TPA). 6. Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) into the corresponding terminal release cavity. The release cavities are the 2 center rows of cavities on one half of the connector. Page 8012 View of a typical Micro 64 connector. Depress the lock and pull the lever over and past the lock. Page 4739 For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 4904 5. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove TPA from the connector. 6. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Page 3959 Important: When reusing the valve train components, always install the components to the original location and position. The valve lash is net build, no valve adjustment is required. 1. Lubricate the valve rocker arms and pushrods with clean engine oil. 2. Lubricate the flange of the valve rocker arm bolts with clean engine oil. 3. Lubricate the flange or washer surface of the bolt that will contact the valve rocker arm. 4. Install the valve rocker arm pivot support. Important: Make sure that the pushrods seat properly to the valve lifter sockets. 5. Install the pushrods. Important: Verify that the pushrods seat properly to the ends of the rocker arms. DO NOT tighten the rocker arm bolts at this time. 6. Install the rocker arms and bolts. Page 4583 Page 5946 - A control module from another vehicle is installed. - Revised software/calibration files have been released for this vehicle. - IMPORTANT: DO NOT re-program the control module with the SAME software/calibration files that are already present in the control module. This is not an effective repair for any type of concern. Verify that the control module contains the correct software/calibration. If incorrect programming is found, reprogram the control module with the most current software/calibration. Refer to Control Module References for replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Testing for Short to Ground TESTING FOR SHORT TO GROUND NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 4. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit. With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is a short to ground in the circuit. Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2. Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). - When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. - If the DMM does not display voltage 4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is shorted. Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A DIGITAL MULTIMETER NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the powertrain control module (PCM), should only be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200 Digital Multimeter (DMM). The J 39200 instruction manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminage even though voltage is present. The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity. IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading. Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the measurement. Page 5219 2. Use a small flat-bladed tool to release the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting the tool in the small recess on the side of the connector and pushing up until the TPA releases from the connector body. The TPA should raise just slightly. Do not try to remove the TPA. IMPORTANT: The TPA on this connector cannot be removed unless the terminals are removed first. The TPA will come out of the connector body, but only slightly. When the TPA is slightly raised the terminals can be removed. Using excessive force to remove the TPA with the terminals still in the connector will damage the connector. 3. Repeat the process for the other side of the connector. 4. Ensure that the TPA is in the proper position to remove the terminals. Service Precautions Valve Spring: Service Precautions Valve Springs Can Be Tightly Compressed Caution Caution: Valve springs can be tightly compressed. Use care when removing retainers and plugs. Personal injury could result. Page 7225 View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. 4. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers CIRCUIT PROTECTION - CIRCUIT BREAKERS A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types of circuit Page 9075 5. While pushing the terminal forward, insert the J 38125-24 in the release cavity above the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (43-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Page 4708 Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Service and Repair Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure Notice: Use care when handling the coolant sensor. Damage to the coolant sensor will affect the operation of the fuel control system. 1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Raise and suitably support the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 3. Drain the cooling system below the level of the ECT sensor. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System (LL8) Draining and Filling Cooling System (LH6, LS2). 4. Lower the vehicle. 5. Disconnect the engine coolant temperature (ECT) sensor electrical connector (1). 6. Remove the ECT sensor. Installation Procedure Notice: Replacement components must be the correct part number for the application. Components requiring the use of the thread locking compound, lubricants, corrosion inhibitors, or sealants are identified in the service procedure. Some replacement components may come with these coatings already applied. Do not use these coatings on components unless specified. These coatings can affect the final torque, which may affect the operation of the component. Use the correct torque specification when installing components in order to avoid damage. Notice: Use care when handling the coolant sensor. Damage to the coolant sensor will affect the operation of the fuel control system. 1. Coat the ECT sensor threads with sealer GM P/N 12346004 (Canadian P/N 10953480), or equivalent. Page 3324 5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape. Seat Belt Schematic Icons Seat Belt Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons Page 468 MEASURING FREQUENCY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal. IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM to autorange to an appropriate range. 1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency measured. Measuring Voltage MEASURING VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit. 1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods: - Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. - Turn ON the engine. - Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls. - Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested. 3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The DMM displays the voltage measured at that point. Measuring Voltage Drop MEASURING VOLTAGE DROP NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points. Probing Electrical Connectors PROBING ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS Page 3220 Fuse Block - Rear, Label Usage Page 2287 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link). - The wire insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. 5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold them between thumb and forefinger. 7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place. - Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction. - Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip. 8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool closes.Ensure that no strands of wire are cut. 10. Crimp the splice on each end (2). Page 2283 11. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 12. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 13. Center the high temperature SCT1 shrink tube over the DuraSeal splice sleeve. 14. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the high temperature heat shrink tubing. 15. Gradually move the heat from the center to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 16. Replace any reflective tape and clips that may have been remove during the repair. Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation REPAIRING DAMAGED WIRE INSULATION Wire Size Conversion Page 3610 of vibration is normally felt more in the "seat of the pants" than the steering wheel. 5. Next, record the Hertz (Hz) reading as displayed by the EVA onto the tire data worksheet found at the end of this bulletin. This should be done after a tire break-in period of at least 16 km (10 mi) at 72 km/h (45 mph) or greater, in order to eliminate any possible tire flat-spotting. This reading confirms what the vehicle vibration frequency is prior to vehicle service and documents the amount of improvement occurring as the result of the various steps taken to repair. Completing the Steering Wheel Shake Worksheet below is required. A copy of the completed worksheet must be saved with the R.O. and a copy included with any parts returned to the Warranty Parts Center for analysis. A reading of 35 to 50 Hz typically indicates a first order propshaft vibration. If this is the situation, refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 08-07-30-044D. Generally, a reading between 10 and 20 Hz indicates a tire/wheel vibration and if this is the reading obtained, continue using this bulletin. If the tire 1st order vibration goes away and stays away during this evaluation, the cause is likely tire flat-spotting. Tire flat-spotting vibration may come and go at any speed over 72 km/h (45 mph) during the first 10 minutes of operation, if vibration continues after 10 minutes of driving at speeds greater than 72 km/h (45 mph), tire flat-spotting can be ruled out as the cause for vibration. 6. If flat-spotting is the cause, provide the explanation that this has occurred due to the vehicle being parked for long periods of time and that the nature of the tire is to take a set. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 03-03-10-007E: Information on Tire/Wheel Characteristics (Vibration, Balance, Shake, Flat Spotting) of GM Original Equipment Tires. 7. If the road test indicates a shake/vibration exists, check the imbalance of each tire/wheel assembly on a known, calibrated, off-car dynamic balancer.Make sure the mounting surface of the wheel and the surface of the balancer are absolutely clean and free of debris. Be sure to chose the proper cone/collet for the wheel, and always use the pilot bore for centering. Never center the wheel using the hub-cap bore since it is not a precision machined surface. If any assembly calls for more than 1/4 ounce on either rim flange, remove all balance weights and rebalance to as close to zero as possible. If you can see the vibration (along with feeling it) in the steering wheel (driving straight without your hands on the wheel), it is very likely to be a tire/wheel first order (one pulse per revolution) disturbance. First order disturbances can be caused by imbalance as well as non-uniformities in tires, wheels or hubs. This first order frequency is too low for a human to hear, but if the amplitude is high enough, it can be seen. If a vibration or shake still exists after balancing, any out of round conditions, of the wheel, and force variation conditions of the tire, must be addressed. Equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700 can address both (it is also a wheel balancer). Tire radial force vibration (RFV) can be defined as the amount of stiffness variation the tire will produce in one revolution under a constant load. Radial force variation is what the vehicle feels because the load (weight) of the vehicle is always on the tires. Although free runout of tires (not under load) is not always a good indicator of a smooth ride, it is critical that total tire/wheel assembly runout be within specification. Equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700 loads the tire, similar to on the vehicle, and measures radial force variation of the tire/wheel assembly. Note that the wheel is affecting the tire's RFV measurement at this point. To isolate the wheel, its runout must be measured. This can be easily done on the Hunter, without the need to set up dial indicators. If the wheel meets the runout specification, the tire's RFV can then be addressed. After measuring the tire/wheel assembly under load, and the wheel alone, the machine then calculates (predicts) the radial force variation of the tire. However, because this is a prediction that can include mounting inaccuracies, and the load wheel is much smaller in diameter than used in tire production, this type of service equipment should NOT be used to audit new tires. Rather, it should be used as a service diagnostic tool to minimize radial force variation of the tire/wheel assembly. Equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700 does an excellent job of measuring wheel runout, and of finding the low point of the wheel (for runout) and the high point of the tire (for radial force variation). This allows the tire to be matched mounted to the wheel for lowest tire/wheel assembly force variation. The machine will simplify this process into easy steps. The following assembly radial force variation numbers should be used as a guide: When measuring RFV and match mounting tires perform the following steps. Measuring Wheel Runout and Assembly Radial Force Variation Important The completed worksheet at the end of this bulletin must be attached to the hard copy of the repair order. - Measure radial force variation and radial runout. - If a road force/balancing machine is used, record the radial force variation (RFV) on the worksheet at the end of this bulletin. It may be of benefit to have the lowest RFV assembly to the front left corner. If the machine is not available and the EVA data suggests there is an issue, swap the tire and wheel assemblies from the front to the back. Re-check on the EVA and if the problem still exists, test another vehicle to find tires that do not exhibit the same frequency and swap those tires onto the subject vehicle. - If a runout/balancing machine is used, record the radial runout of the tire/wheel assemblies on the worksheet at the end of this bulletin. If one or more of the tire/wheel assemblies are more than.040 in (1.02 mm), match mount the tire to the wheel to get below.040 in (1.02 mm). For sensitive customers, readings of 0.030 inch (0.76 mm) or less are preferable, it may also be of benefit to have the lowest runout assembly to the front left corner. If the machine is not available and the EVA data suggests there is an issue, swap the tire and wheel assemblies from the front to the back. Re-check on the EVA and if the problem still exists, test another vehicle to find tires that do not exhibit the same frequency and swap those tires Page 200 - Kostel - Molex - Sumitomo - Tyco/AMP - Yazaki Identifying the manufacturer of a connector is often difficult. When trying to determine the manufacturer of a connector, look for specific identifying marks that are unique to that connector supplier. Most of these identify marks are hard to find or see. Check the connector carefully and refer to the information below for pictures and descriptions of connector identification markings. - Most of AFLs connectors have EPC on their connector body. Some of the smaller connectors will not have any markings on them. - In some cases Bosch will actually be printed on the connector. If Bosch does not appear on the connector, look for the Bosch logo. The Bosch logo is a circle with a blunted arrow inside. This logo can appear anywhere on the connector and is often very small. Page 498 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert terminal into the appropriate terminal holder until it hits bottom and stops. The correct terminal holder is determined by the wire size. Also ensure that the terminals wings are pointing towards the former on the tool and the release locator. 5. Insert the stripped cable into the terminal. Insulation should be visible on both sides of the terminal insulation wings. 6. Compress the handles until the ratchet automatically releases. 7. Place the terminal into the appropriate cavity and assemble the connector. Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO-PACK 100W) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W connectors. These connectors are very similar but use different terminals and have some minor physical differences also. Page 8934 Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. FCI Connectors FCI CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 3889 Connecting Rod: Specifications Connecting Rod Bolts First Pass ............................................................................................................................................. .............................................. 20 N.m (15 lb ft) Final Pass .................................................................. .................................................................................................................................. 75 degrees Connecting Rod Connecting Rod Bearing Clearance Production ........................................................................................................................................................... 0.023-0.065 mm (0.0009-0.0025 in) Service ....................................................................................... ........................................................................... 0.023-0.076 mm (0.0009-0.003 in) Connecting Rod Bore Diameter - Bearing End ............................................................................................................. 56.505-56.525 mm (2.224-2.225 in) Connecting Rod Bore Out-of-Round - Bearing End Production ......................................................................................................................................................... 0.004-0.008 mm (0.00015-0.0003 in) Service .............................................................................................................................................................. 0.004-0.008 mm (0.00015-0.0003 in) Connecting Rod Side Clearance ..................................................................................................................................... 0.11-0.51 mm (0.00433-0.02 in) Crankshaft Connecting Rod Journal Diameter Production ....................................................................................................................................................... 53.318-53.338 mm (2.0991-2.0999 in) Service ................................................................................... .................................................................................................. 53.308 mm (2.0987 in) Connecting Rod Journal Out-of-Round Production ........................................................................................................................................... ...................................... 0.005 mm (0.0002 in) Service ...................................................................... ................................................................................................................... 0.01 mm (0.0004 in) Connecting Rod Journal Taper - Maximum for 1/2 of Journal Length Production ........................................................................................................................................... ...................................... 0.005 mm (0.0002 in) Service ...................................................................... ................................................................................................................. 0.02 mm (0.00078 in) Page 245 2. Use a small flat-bladed tool to release the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting the tool in the small recess on the side of the connector and pushing up until the TPA releases from the connector body. The TPA should raise just slightly. Do not try to remove the TPA. IMPORTANT: The TPA on this connector cannot be removed unless the terminals are removed first. The TPA will come out of the connector body, but only slightly. When the TPA is slightly raised the terminals can be removed. Using excessive force to remove the TPA with the terminals still in the connector will damage the connector. 3. Repeat the process for the other side of the connector. 4. Ensure that the TPA is in the proper position to remove the terminals. Page 7336 Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested: - Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. - Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a component or to other harnesses. - If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A TEST LAMP TOOLS REQUIRED J 35616-200 Test Light - Probe Kit NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminate even though voltage is present. The J 35616-200 is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair of leads. To properly operate this tool use the following procedures. When testing for voltage: 1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested. When testing for ground: 1. Attach one lead to battery positive voltage. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where ground should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is ground at the point being tested. Using Connector Test Adapters USING CONNECTOR TEST ADAPTERS NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Using Fused Jumper Wires USING FUSED JUMPER WIRES TOOLS REQUIRED J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged. The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested. AFL/ECP Connectors AFL/EPC CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 6228 Release the lower wiredress cover locking tab. Release the upper wiredress cover locking tab. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. Page 713 The first connector design of the Micro-Pack 100W (1) has a white connector interface that holds the terminals. The second design of the Micro-Pack 100W (2) has a gray interface to hold the terminals. Also, the first design has terminal cavities that are further apart (3 mm centerline) and offset from the other row of terminal cavities in the connector. The second design has terminals cavities that are closer together (2.54 mm centerline) and aligned vertically. One other way to identify the second design is the thin strip of material that runs along the outside of the cavities. IMPORTANT: There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W terminals which are very similar. Ensure that you have the correct terminal before crimping the new terminal to the wire. The first design connector uses the longer terminal (1) that has a raised area in front of the recess in the terminal. The second design connector uses the shorter terminal without the raised area. Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro-Pack 100W connectors. Some Micro-Pack 100W connector disassembly procedures will vary. Use this procedure as a guide. 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 6310 Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. For connectors with a bolt in the dress cover, turn the bolt counterclockwise to remove the connector from the component. 2. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. Page 1340 View of the connector when released from the component. View of another type of Micro 64 connector. Page 2403 US English/Metric Conversion US English/Metric Conversion Page 5384 Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Testing and Inspection Powertrain Relay Diagnosis Diagnostic Instructions * Perform the Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle prior to using this diagnostic procedure. * Strategy Based Diagnosis for an overview of the diagnostic approach. * Diagnostic Procedure Instructions provide an overview of each diagnostic category. Typical Scan Tool Data Circuit/System Description The powertrain relay is a normally open relay. The relay armature is held in the open position by spring tension. Battery positive voltage is supplied directly to the relay coil and the armature contact at all times. The engine control module (ECM) supplies the ground path to the relay coil control circuit via an internal integrated circuit called an output driver module (ODM). The ODM output control is configured to operate as a low side driver for the powertrain relay. The ODM for the powertrain relay also incorporates a fault detection circuit, which is continuously monitored by the ECM. When the ECM commands the powertrain relay ON, ignition 1 voltage is supplied to the ECM, and to several additional circuits. Diagnostic Aids This test procedure requires that the vehicle battery has passed a load test and is completely charged. Refer to Battery Inspection/Test. See: Starting and Charging/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics/Battery Inspection/Test Circuit/System Verification Important: On the scan tool, the powertrain relay is referred to as the EC ignition relay. 1. Ignition ON, engine OFF, command the powertrain relay ON and OFF several times using the scan tool output control function. You should either hear or feel the relay click with each command. 2. Ignition ON, engine OFF, with a test lamp, probe both test points of all the fuses that are powered by the powertrain relay. The test lamp should illuminate on at least one test point of each fuse. ‹› If the vehicle passes the Circuit/System Verification test, then operate the vehicle within the Conditions for Running the DTC. You may also operate the vehicle within the conditions that are captured in the Freeze Frame/Failure Records Data list. Circuit/System Testing 1. Ignition OFF, disconnect the powertrain relay. 2. Ignition ON, verify that a test lamp does not illuminate between the relay coil control circuit and ground. ‹› If the test lamp illuminates, test the relay coil control circuit for a short to voltage. If the circuit tests normal, replace the ECM. 3. Verify that a test lamp does not illuminate between the relay ignition 1 voltage circuit and ground. ‹› If the test lamp illuminates, test the relay ignition 1 voltage circuit for a short to voltage. If the circuit tests normal, replace the ECM. 4. Verify that a test lamp illuminates between the relay coil B+ and ground. ‹› If the test lamp does not illuminate, test the relay coil B+ circuit for a short to ground or an open/high resistance. 5. Verify that a test lamp illuminates between the relay switch B+ and ground. ‹› If the test lamp does not illuminate, test the relay switch B+ circuit for a short to ground or an open/high resistance. If the circuits test normal and the fuse for the ignition 1 voltage circuit is open, test the ignition 1 voltage circuit to the ECM for a short to ground. If the circuit tests Page 8717 3. Ensure that the terminal release tang access panel is in the correct location to access the terminals. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) into the terminal release tang access slot located behind the access panel of the connector and press down on the terminal while carefully pulling the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Tyco/AMP Connectors (0.25 Cap) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (025 CAP) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component by pressing down on the connector position assurance (CPA). Page 1593 View of the connector when released from the component. View of another type of Micro 64 connector. Page 6546 Connector Anatomy Connector Repairs contains a list of all connector repairs. The connector repairs are listed by the connector manufacturer and then by connector type. If the technician cannot identify the manufacturer of the connector, refer to Identifying Connectors below. Knowing the connector manufacturer will assist in finding the correct connector repair from the following list: - Connector Position Assurance Locks - Terminal Position Assurance Locks - Bosch Connectors (0.64) Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) Bosch Connectors (BSK) Bosch Connectors (ECM) - Delphi Connectors (Micro.64) Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) Delphi Connectors (12-Way) - Tyco/AMP Connectors (CM 42-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) Tyco/AMP Connectors (025 Cap) Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) - Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) - Repairing Connector Terminals IDENTIFYING CONNECTORS Knowing the connector manufacturer is helpful when trying to locating the correct connector repair procedure. There are many different connector designs used on GM vehicles and it is sometimes difficult to identify the connector manufacturer. The information in this document should help with the identification of connector manufactures. The following connector manufacturers make most of the connectors found in GM vehicles: AFL/EPC (Alcoa Fujikura Ltd./Engineered Plastics Components) - Bosch - Delphi - FCI (Framatome Connectors International) - JAE (Japan Aviation Electronics) - JST (Japan Solderless Terminals) Page 7405 If a wire is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm, etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except coaxial. - Do not use the DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent American wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 6837 Ignition Cable: Testing and Inspection Spark Plug Wire Inspection Spark plug wire integrity is vital for proper engine operation. A thorough inspection is necessary to accurately identify conditions that may affect engine operation. Inspect for the following conditions: 1. Correct routing of the spark plug wires - Incorrect routing may cause cross-firing. 2. Any signs of cracks or splits in the wires. 3. Inspect each boot for the following conditions: * Tearing * Piercing * Arcing * Carbon tracking * Corroded terminal If corrosion, carbon tracking or arcing are indicated on a spark plug wire boot or terminal, replace the wire and the component connected to the wire. Page 5709 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. JST Connectors JST CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, remove the connector from the component. Page 7826 View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. 4. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers CIRCUIT PROTECTION - CIRCUIT BREAKERS A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types of circuit Page 2604 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. JST Connectors JST CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, remove the connector from the component. Page 8899 - A control module from another vehicle is installed. - Revised software/calibration files have been released for this vehicle. - IMPORTANT: DO NOT re-program the control module with the SAME software/calibration files that are already present in the control module. This is not an effective repair for any type of concern. Verify that the control module contains the correct software/calibration. If incorrect programming is found, reprogram the control module with the most current software/calibration. Refer to Control Module References for replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Testing for Short to Ground TESTING FOR SHORT TO GROUND NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 4. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit. With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is a short to ground in the circuit. Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2. Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). - When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. - If the DMM does not display voltage 4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is shorted. Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A DIGITAL MULTIMETER NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the powertrain control module (PCM), should only be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200 Digital Multimeter (DMM). The J 39200 instruction manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminage even though voltage is present. The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity. IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading. Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the measurement. Page 8599 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches, and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original. - The wires insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the possibility of fuel contact. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1). 5. Select the proper duraseal splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool. Refer to the Crimp and Seal Splice Table. 6. Place the duraseal splice sleeve in the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115) crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 7. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to hold the duraseal splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 8. Insert the wires into the duraseal splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel in order to prevent the wire from passing through the splice (3). 9. Close the handles of the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115), until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is applied to the splice sleeve. 10. Shrink the insulation around the splice. - Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. - Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Splicing Inline Harness Diodes SPLICING INLINE HARNESS DIODES Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure. 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode. 2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool. 5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode. Page 2445 11. Insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) into the 2 triangular cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 12. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE 1. Prior to installation the terminal must be aligned so the (1) coding lugs align with the (2) coding grooves on the connector. 2. Once the terminal is aligned, slide the terminal into the cavity until the retainer has engaged in the cavity of the connector. 3. Slide the TPA in the connector body and seat it using a small flat bladed tool. The TPA is seated when it is flush with the contact housing. 4. Secure the wires to the connector body using a tie wrap and replace the dress cover and grommet. Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) BOSCH CONNECTORS (2.8 JPT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Pull out the slider on the connector position assurance (CPA) until it is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 8426 4. Slide the dress cover forward and off of the connector. 5. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front and rear of the connector. Page 6532 - A control module from another vehicle is installed. - Revised software/calibration files have been released for this vehicle. - IMPORTANT: DO NOT re-program the control module with the SAME software/calibration files that are already present in the control module. This is not an effective repair for any type of concern. Verify that the control module contains the correct software/calibration. If incorrect programming is found, reprogram the control module with the most current software/calibration. Refer to Control Module References for replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Testing for Short to Ground TESTING FOR SHORT TO GROUND NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 4. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit. With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is a short to ground in the circuit. Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2. Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). - When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. - If the DMM does not display voltage 4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is shorted. Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A DIGITAL MULTIMETER NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the powertrain control module (PCM), should only be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200 Digital Multimeter (DMM). The J 39200 instruction manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminage even though voltage is present. The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity. IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading. Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the measurement. Page 4802 - JST connectors have JST in small letters on their connectors, similar to that above. The location of the logo will vary with the connector size and style. - Kostel has an "LK" with a circle around it. These connector are usually used as a transmissions connection and are currently use on some Cadillac vehicles. Page 7474 MEASURING FREQUENCY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal. IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM to autorange to an appropriate range. 1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency measured. Measuring Voltage MEASURING VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit. 1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods: - Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. - Turn ON the engine. - Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls. - Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested. 3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The DMM displays the voltage measured at that point. Measuring Voltage Drop MEASURING VOLTAGE DROP NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points. Probing Electrical Connectors PROBING ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS Page 5617 Page 8500 Page 1857 IMPORTANT: Ensure that the dress cover and connector body are both in the released position before reassembling. Failure to do so may cause damage to the connector and component. Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (0.64) BOSCH CONNECTORS (0.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While pressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock until the lever is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Pull the rubber boot that covers the wires back to expose the end of the connector dress cover. 4. Place the connector locking lever in the center of the connector. 5. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs that are on the wire end of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover and connector body and pry up. Page 500 2. Locate the nose piece locking tabs that are positioned on the side of the connector nose piece. The connector nose piece acts as a terminal positive assurance (TPA) and may be referred to as such. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to push in one of the locking tabs while gently pulling on the same side of the nose piece. 4. Repeat the procedure for the other locking tab and remove the nose piece. 5. Remove the wire dress cover. The following is a general procedure for wire dress cover removal. Use this procedure as a guide, some dress cover removal procedures may vary. 6. Use fingers to squeeze the 2 locking legs of the cover. Page 6610 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link). - The wire insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. 5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold them between thumb and forefinger. 7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place. - Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction. - Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip. 8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool closes.Ensure that no strands of wire are cut. 10. Crimp the splice on each end (2). Page 7013 MEASURING FREQUENCY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal. IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM to autorange to an appropriate range. 1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency measured. Measuring Voltage MEASURING VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit. 1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods: - Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. - Turn ON the engine. - Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls. - Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested. 3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The DMM displays the voltage measured at that point. Measuring Voltage Drop MEASURING VOLTAGE DROP NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points. Probing Electrical Connectors PROBING ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS Page 3104 All 2006 and future model transmissions that use DEXRON(R)-VI are to be serviced ONLY with DEXRON(R)-VI fluid. DEXRON(R)-VI is an improvement over DEXRON(R)-III in the following areas: * These ATF change intervals remain the same as DEXRON(R)-III for the time being. 2006-2008 Transmission Fill and Cooler Flushing Some new applications of the 6L80 six speed transmission will require the use of the J 45096 Flushing and Flow Tester to accomplish transmission fluid fill. The clean oil reservoir of the machine should be purged of DEXRON(R)-III and filled with DEXRON(R)-VI. Parts Information Disclaimer Page 6563 The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors. 1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position. 4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool J 38125-10A (GM P/N 12014012-1) into the front (mating end) of the connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal through the back of the connector (2). IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector. 6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. 7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily. 10. Perform system check. Delphi Connectors (12 Way) DELPHI CONNECTORS (12-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. Page 8382 It is very important to use the correct test adapter when testing for proper terminal contact of fuses and relays in a bussed electrical center (BEC). Use J-35616-35 to test for proper terminal contact. Failure to use J-35616-35 can result in improper diagnosis of the BEC. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Separate the connector halves. 2. Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body. 3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J-38125 , test that the retention force is significantly different between a good terminal and a suspect terminal. Replace the female terminal in question. FLAT WIRE (DOCK AND LOCK) CONNECTORS There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock) connectors on the harness side or the component side. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Remove the component in question. 2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side of the connector as oil from your skin may be a source of contamination as well. 3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other imperfections that could cause poor terminal contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are uniform and free of damage or deformation. 4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the on the flat wire harness connector in order to test the circuit in question. CONTROL MODULE/COMPONENT VOLTAGE AND GROUNDS Poor voltage or ground connections can cause widely varying symptoms. Test all control module voltage supply circuits. Many vehicles have multiple circuits supplying voltage to a control module. Other components in the system may have separate voltage supply circuits that may also need to be tested. Inspect connections at the module/component connectors, fuses, and any intermediate connections between the voltage source and the module/component. A test lamp or a DMM may indicate that voltage is present, but neither tests the ability of the circuit to carry sufficient current. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Power Distribution Schematics. - Test all control module ground and system ground circuits. The control module may have multiple ground circuits. Other components in the system may have separate grounds that may also need to be tested. Inspect grounds for clean and tight connections at the grounding point. Inspect the connections at the component and in splice packs, where applicable. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Ground Distribution Schematics. TEMPERATURE SENSITIVITY - An intermittent condition may occur when a component/connection reaches normal operating temperature. The condition may occur only when the component/connection is cold, or only when the component/connection is hot. - Freeze Frame, Failure Records, Snapshot, or Vehicle Data Recorder data may help with this type of intermittent condition, where applicable. - If the intermittent is related to heat, review the data for a relationship with the following: High ambient temperatures - Underhood/engine generated heat - Circuit generated heat due to a poor connection, or high electrical load - Higher than normal load conditions, towing, etc. - If the intermittent is related to cold, review the data for the following: Low ambient temperatures-In extremely low temperatures, ice may form in a connection or component. Inspect for water intrusion. - The condition only occurs on a cold start. - The condition goes away when the vehicle warms up. - Information from the customer may help to determine if the trouble follows a pattern that is temperature related. - If temperature is suspected of causing an intermittent fault condition, attempt to duplicate the condition. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required. ELECTROMAGNETIC INTERFERENCE (EMI) AND ELECTRICAL NOISE Some electrical components/circuits are sensitive to electromagnetic interference (EMI) or other types of electrical noise. Inspect for the following conditions: A misrouted harness that is too close to high voltage/high current devices such as secondary ignition components, motors, generator etc-These components may induce electrical noise on a circuit that could interfere with normal circuit operation. - Electrical system interference caused by a malfunctioning relay, or a control module driven solenoid or switch-These conditions can cause a sharp electrical surge. Normally, the condition will occur when the malfunctioning component is operating. - Improper installation of non-factory or aftermarket add on accessories such as lights, 2-way radios, amplifiers, electric motors, remote starters, alarm systems, cell phones, etc-These accessories may lead to interference while in use, but do not fail when the accessories are not in use. - Test for an open diode across the A/C compressor clutch and for other open diodes. Some relays may contain a clamping diode. - The generator may be allowing AC noise into the electrical system. INCORRECT CONTROL MODULE - There are only a few situations where reprogramming a control module is appropriate: A new service control module is installed. Page 8243 It is very important to use the correct test adapter when testing for proper terminal contact of fuses and relays in a bussed electrical center (BEC). Use J-35616-35 to test for proper terminal contact. Failure to use J-35616-35 can result in improper diagnosis of the BEC. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Separate the connector halves. 2. Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body. 3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J-38125 , test that the retention force is significantly different between a good terminal and a suspect terminal. Replace the female terminal in question. FLAT WIRE (DOCK AND LOCK) CONNECTORS There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock) connectors on the harness side or the component side. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Remove the component in question. 2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side of the connector as oil from your skin may be a source of contamination as well. 3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other imperfections that could cause poor terminal contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are uniform and free of damage or deformation. 4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the on the flat wire harness connector in order to test the circuit in question. CONTROL MODULE/COMPONENT VOLTAGE AND GROUNDS Poor voltage or ground connections can cause widely varying symptoms. Test all control module voltage supply circuits. Many vehicles have multiple circuits supplying voltage to a control module. Other components in the system may have separate voltage supply circuits that may also need to be tested. Inspect connections at the module/component connectors, fuses, and any intermediate connections between the voltage source and the module/component. A test lamp or a DMM may indicate that voltage is present, but neither tests the ability of the circuit to carry sufficient current. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Power Distribution Schematics. - Test all control module ground and system ground circuits. The control module may have multiple ground circuits. Other components in the system may have separate grounds that may also need to be tested. Inspect grounds for clean and tight connections at the grounding point. Inspect the connections at the component and in splice packs, where applicable. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Ground Distribution Schematics. TEMPERATURE SENSITIVITY - An intermittent condition may occur when a component/connection reaches normal operating temperature. The condition may occur only when the component/connection is cold, or only when the component/connection is hot. - Freeze Frame, Failure Records, Snapshot, or Vehicle Data Recorder data may help with this type of intermittent condition, where applicable. - If the intermittent is related to heat, review the data for a relationship with the following: High ambient temperatures - Underhood/engine generated heat - Circuit generated heat due to a poor connection, or high electrical load - Higher than normal load conditions, towing, etc. - If the intermittent is related to cold, review the data for the following: Low ambient temperatures-In extremely low temperatures, ice may form in a connection or component. Inspect for water intrusion. - The condition only occurs on a cold start. - The condition goes away when the vehicle warms up. - Information from the customer may help to determine if the trouble follows a pattern that is temperature related. - If temperature is suspected of causing an intermittent fault condition, attempt to duplicate the condition. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required. ELECTROMAGNETIC INTERFERENCE (EMI) AND ELECTRICAL NOISE Some electrical components/circuits are sensitive to electromagnetic interference (EMI) or other types of electrical noise. Inspect for the following conditions: A misrouted harness that is too close to high voltage/high current devices such as secondary ignition components, motors, generator etc-These components may induce electrical noise on a circuit that could interfere with normal circuit operation. - Electrical system interference caused by a malfunctioning relay, or a control module driven solenoid or switch-These conditions can cause a sharp electrical surge. Normally, the condition will occur when the malfunctioning component is operating. - Improper installation of non-factory or aftermarket add on accessories such as lights, 2-way radios, amplifiers, electric motors, remote starters, alarm systems, cell phones, etc-These accessories may lead to interference while in use, but do not fail when the accessories are not in use. - Test for an open diode across the A/C compressor clutch and for other open diodes. Some relays may contain a clamping diode. - The generator may be allowing AC noise into the electrical system. INCORRECT CONTROL MODULE - There are only a few situations where reprogramming a control module is appropriate: A new service control module is installed. Page 6611 11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the solder equipment. 12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. 13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to cover the first piece of tape. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE SLEEVES TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit IMPORTANT: Use only dura seal splice sleeves. Other splice sleeves may not protect the splice from moisture or provide a good electrical connection. Use duraseal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. Use duraseal splice sleeves where there is special requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire using duraseal splice sleeves. Page 8947 8. Insert the J 38125-213 into the small terminal release hole on the nose piece and gently pull on the back of the wire. 9. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Repairing Connector Terminals REPAIRING CONNECTOR TERMINALS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following: Push to Seat terminals - Pull to Seat terminals Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your terminal repair. The J-38125 contains further information. 1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.For cable seal terminals, remove the seal. 2. Apply the correct cable seal per gage size of the wire, if used.Slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation removal. 3. Remove the insulation. 4. For sealed terminals only, align the seal with the end of the cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal.For sealed terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal. 6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.For sealed terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable. 8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals excepting Micro-Pack 100.64 size. Soldering Micro-Pack 100 World terminals may damage the terminal. Sumitomo Connectors SUMITOMO CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 3955 1. Relieve the fuel system pressure, if required. Perform the following steps: Caution: Wrap a shop towel around the fuel pressure connection in order to reduce the risk of fire and personal injury. The towel will absorb any fuel leakage that occurs during the connection of the fuel pressure gage. Place the towel in an approved container when the connection of the fuel pressure gage is complete. 1. Wrap a shop towel around the fuel rail service port. 2. Place the hose on the CH-48027-2 (2) into an approved gasoline container. 3. Open the valve on the CH-48027-2 (2) in order to bleed any fuel from the fuel rail. 4. Close the valve on the CH-48027-2 (2). 5. Remove the hose on the CH-48027-2 (2) from the approved gasoline container. 6. Remove the shop towel from around the fuel rail service port, and place in an approved gasoline container. Notice: Clean all of the following areas before performing any disconnections in order to avoid possible contamination in the system: * The fuel pipe connections * The hose connections * The areas surrounding the connections Disconnect the CH-48027-1 (1) from the CH-48027-2 (2). 2. Disconnect the CH-48027-2 (2) from the CH-48027-3 (4). 3. Disconnect the CH-48027-3 (4) from the fuel rail service port. 4. Install the fuel rail service port cap. 5. Tighten the fuel fill cap. Page 4911 - In some cases Delphi will actually be printed on the connector. If Delphi is not printed on the connector, look for PED. In both cases there is no specific orientation for Delphi or PED and they can appear anywhere on the connector. - FCI connectors may have the FCI logo on their connectors. The logo is the letters FCI with an "A" above it. - JAE connector have JAE in small letters on their connectors. Page 1324 Release the tabs that are holding the wiredress cover to the connector body. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the slots on both ends of the connector body. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. J 38125-216 can also be used to remove the nose piece. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by lifting the terminal retaining tabs on the inside of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 7090 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Start in the middle and gradually move the heat barrel to the open ends of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Heated Oxygen Sensor Wiring Repairs HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being obstructed. If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. - Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks, etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire. - Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance. - To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector. Page 5432 Connector Anatomy Connector Repairs contains a list of all connector repairs. The connector repairs are listed by the connector manufacturer and then by connector type. If the technician cannot identify the manufacturer of the connector, refer to Identifying Connectors below. Knowing the connector manufacturer will assist in finding the correct connector repair from the following list: - Connector Position Assurance Locks - Terminal Position Assurance Locks - Bosch Connectors (0.64) Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) Bosch Connectors (BSK) Bosch Connectors (ECM) - Delphi Connectors (Micro.64) Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) Delphi Connectors (12-Way) - Tyco/AMP Connectors (CM 42-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) Tyco/AMP Connectors (025 Cap) Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) - Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) - Repairing Connector Terminals IDENTIFYING CONNECTORS Knowing the connector manufacturer is helpful when trying to locating the correct connector repair procedure. There are many different connector designs used on GM vehicles and it is sometimes difficult to identify the connector manufacturer. The information in this document should help with the identification of connector manufactures. The following connector manufacturers make most of the connectors found in GM vehicles: AFL/EPC (Alcoa Fujikura Ltd./Engineered Plastics Components) - Bosch - Delphi - FCI (Framatome Connectors International) - JAE (Japan Aviation Electronics) - JST (Japan Solderless Terminals) Page 4394 View of a typical Micro 64 connector. Depress the lock and pull the lever over and past the lock. Page 4246 Timing Cover: Service and Repair Engine Front Cover Replacement Tools Required J 41476 Front and Rear Cover Alignment Tool (at crankshaft seal area) Removal Procedure 1. Remove the air conditioning (A/C) compressor and bracket. Refer to Compressor Replacement (LH6, LS2) Compressor Replacement (LL8). 2. Remove the water pump. Refer to Water Pump Replacement (LH6 and LS2). 3. Remove the crankshaft balancer. Refer to Crankshaft Balancer Replacement. 4. Remove the oil pan-to-front cover bolts. 5. Remove the front cover bolts. 6. Remove the front cover and gasket. 7. Discard the front cover gasket. 8. Clean and inspect the engine front cover. Refer to Engine Front Cover Cleaning and Inspection. Installation Procedure Page 2278 Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size. REPAIRING A FUSIBLE LINK IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient overload protection. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. Flat Wire Repairs FLAT WIRE REPAIRS NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced. GMLAN Wiring Repairs GMLAN WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The GM Local Area Network (GMLAN) System requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working on GMLAN connectors and terminals. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items in order to repair the GMLAN wiring: Dura Seal splice sleeves - A wire stripping tool - J 38125-8 Crimping Tool (GM P/N 12085115) - J 38125-5 Ultra Torch Special Tool (GM P/N 12085116) The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. - A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors GMLAN REPAIRS IMPORTANT: When making a repair to any GMLAN network, the original wire length after the repair must be the same length as before the repair. If the network is a twisted pair, the twist must be maintained after the repair is completed. GMLAN has 2 types of networks, low speed and high speed. Low speed GMLAN has a single wire and works at slow speeds. High speed GMLAN has 2 wires in a twisted pair and works at higher speeds. For more information on GMLAN, refer to Data Link Communications Description and Operation. GMLAN CONNECTOR TERMINAL REPAIR IMPORTANT: A service terminal can be used to replace damaged connector terminals for both high speed and low speed GMLAN systems. When making a connector terminal repair on a GMLAN high speed system with twisted pair wires, do not untwist the wires more than necessary to make the repair. The terminals in the GMLAN system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are available in the J-38125. If the individual terminals are damaged on any GMLAN connection, use the appropriate connector repair procedure in order to repair the terminal. GMLAN WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 8262 - Most Molex connectors will have the Molex logo on the dresscover of the connector. In some cases the connectors may have MX followed by another letter. The third letter indicates where the connector was made. A connector with MXD is a Molex connector made in Detroit. Sumitomo has a unique symbol on their connector and possibly a part number. The symbol is similar to that of a diamond lying on its side, similar to that shown. The logo could appear anywhere but the most common place is at the wire side of the housing. Tyco/AMP has many different and unique connector designs. Some may or may not have identifiable marks on them. Page 1805 1. Install the MAP sensor (1). Push the MAP sensor into the intake manifold. 2. Install the MAP sensor retainer (2) to the intake manifold. 3. Connect the MAP sensor electrical connector (3). Page 1435 Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. For connectors with a bolt in the dress cover, turn the bolt counterclockwise to remove the connector from the component. 2. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. Page 5371 If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the DuraSeal splice sleeves. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: - Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. - Do not use the crimp and DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 to crimp DuraSeal splice sleeve. In order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 5425 difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Bosch Connectors (ECM) BOSCH CONNECTORS (ECM) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the assist lever on the top of the connector. Move the assist lever to the forward position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 7105 Camshaft Position Sensor: Connector Views Engine Controls Connector End Views Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor Page 8666 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. 4. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front of the connector. Page 2483 3. Remove the dress cover by using a flat-blade tool to release the connector locking tabs and pulling off the dress cover. 4. Relieve the tension on the nose piece retainers by inserting J-38125-12A (12094429) into the single retainer slot on the end of the nose piece and gently prying out the locking tab. Repeat the process for both of the nose piece locking tabs on the opposite side of the nose piece. Page 3525 3. Insert the sensor in the wheel hole with the air passage facing away from the wheel. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 4. Install the sensor nut and position the sensor body parallel to the inside wheel surface while torquing. Tighten the sensor nut to 7 N.m (62 lb in). Important: Before installing the tire on the wheel, note the following items to avoid tire pressure sensor damage upon tire mounting: ^ Position the mounting/dismounting head 180 degrees from the valve stem. ^ Position the bead transition area 45 degrees counterclockwise of the valve stem. ^ Using the tire machine, rotate the tire/wheel assembly clockwise when transferring the tire bead to the inside of the wheel rim. ^ Repeat items for outer bead. Install the tire on the wheel. Refer to Tire Mounting and Dismounting . ^ Install the tire/wheel assembly on the vehicle. Refer to Tire and Wheel Removal and Installation. ^ Lower the vehicle. Page 5357 Release the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the blue locking tabs on both ends of the connector. Gently slide the TPA up to the released position on both ends. 6. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-13A (GM P/N 12031876-1) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. Page 4654 5. While pushing the terminal forward, insert the J 38125-24 in the release cavity above the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (43-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Page 8529 IMPORTANT: Ensure that the dress cover and connector body are both in the released position before reassembling. Failure to do so may cause damage to the connector and component. Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (0.64) BOSCH CONNECTORS (0.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While pressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock until the lever is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Pull the rubber boot that covers the wires back to expose the end of the connector dress cover. 4. Place the connector locking lever in the center of the connector. 5. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs that are on the wire end of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover and connector body and pry up. Engine - MIL ON P0116/P1400 Set In Very Cold Temps Engine Block Heater: Customer Interest Engine - MIL ON P0116/P1400 Set In Very Cold Temps TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 10-06-04-008A Date: January 24, 2011 Subject: Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) Illuminated at Very Cold Ambient Temperatures When Using Engine Coolant Heater, DTC P0116 and/or P1400 Set (Relocate Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor and Engine Coolant Heater Cord) Models: 2006-2007 Buick Rainier 2009 Buick LaCrosse Super, Allure Super (Canada Only) 2006-2010 Cadillac Escalade 2006-2007 Chevrolet Monte Carlo 2006-2009 Chevrolet Impala SS, TrailBlazer 2006-2010 Chevrolet Avalanche, Express, Silverado Tahoe 2006-2009 GMC Envoy 2006-2010 GMC Savana, Sierra, Yukon 2006-2008 Pontiac Grand Prix 2006-2009 Saab 9-7X Equipped with V8 Engine RPO LC9, LH6, LH8, LH9, L76, LS2, LS4, LFA, LZ1, L92, L94, L9H or L20, L96, LMF, LMG, LY2, LY5, LY6 Please Refer to GMVIS Attention: To properly correct this condition, you must follow both of the procedures to relocate the ECT sensor and the engine coolant heater cord. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add cast iron block engine RPOs and to update the Warranty Information coverage period. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 10-06-04-008 (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). Condition Some customers may comment that the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) illuminates after starting the vehicle when they were using the engine coolant heater in very cold ambient temperatures. This usually occurs in a range of -23 to -40°C (-10 to -40°F) or colder. The technician may observe on a scan tool DTC P0116 and/or P1400 set as Current or in History. Cause This condition may be caused by the engine control module (ECM) determining that the ignition OFF time requirement has been met at start-up and interpreting the temperature difference between the engine coolant temperature (ECT) sensor and the intake air temperature (IAT) sensor as being outside of a calibrated range. Correction Important DO NOT replace the ECM for this condition. Relocating the ECT Sensor 1. Turn ON the ignition with the engine OFF. 2. Perform the diagnostic system check - vehicle. Refer to Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle in SI. ‹› If DTC P0116 and/or P1400 are set and the customer WAS using the engine coolant heater, proceed to Step 3. ‹› If DTC P0116 and/or P1400 are set and the customer WAS NOT using the engine coolant heater, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle in SI. 3. Turn OFF the ignition. Warning To avoid being burned, do not remove the radiator cap or surge tank cap while the engine is hot. The cooling system will release scalding fluid and steam Page 734 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. 4. Remove the dress cover by using a flat bladed tool to release the dress cover locking tabs and lift up on the dress cover. 5. Cut the tie wrap that holds the wires to the connector body. Page 2605 2. Locate the two indents of the terminal position assurance (TPA) located on the bottom of the connector body. Page 6126 3. Use a small flat-bladed tool to gently pry off the dress cover by inserting the tool under the cover opposite the harness side and prying up. 4. Remove the cover. 5. Using a small flat-bladed tool, push on the side of the nose piece retainer while pushing the nose piece forward with your thumb. This will release the terminal position assurance (TPA). 6. Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) into the corresponding terminal release cavity. The release cavities are the 2 center rows of cavities on one half of the connector. Page 1271 3. Install the horn plunger to the steering column. 4. Install the inflator module. 5. Enable the SIR system. Refer to SIR Disabling and Enabling. Page 1452 - Yazaki has a wedge or arrow shape, similar to that shown. Delphi Connectors (Micro .64) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro 64 connectors. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. The lever lock may be located on the top or sides of the wire dress cover. Page 5620 Important: Before installing the camshaft sensor assembly, apply a small amount of clean motor oil to the O-ring (6). 4. Install the camshaft position sensor assembly (4, 5, 6) in the front cover (7). Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 5. Install the camshaft position sensor mounting bolts. Tighten the camshaft position mounting bolts 25 N.m (18 lb ft). 6. Install the generator assembly. Air Temperature Sensor Replacement - Upper Right Side Discharge Air Temperature Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair Air Temperature Sensor Replacement - Upper Right Side Air Temperature Sensor Replacement - Upper Right Side Removal Procedure 1. Remove the radio. 2. Disconnect the electrical connector (2) from the air temperature sensor - upper right (1). 3. Remove the air temperature sensor - upper right (1) by turning the sensor clockwise and pulling out. Installation Procedure 1. Install the air temperature sensor - upper right (1). 2. Connect the electrical connector (2) to the air temperature sensor - upper right (1). 3. Install the radio. Re Page 1935 Page 8297 9. The illustration shows a cutaway view of the connector to aid the technician in releasing the terminal retainer. 10. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Terminal Position Assurance Locks TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Tyco/Amp Connectors (CM 42-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (CM 42-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the connector body and pull the CPA out. The CPA is on the wire harness side of connector. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 6351 4. Slide the dress cover forward and off of the connector. 5. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front and rear of the connector. Page 5903 Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Service and Repair Manifold Absolute Pressure Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Disconnect the manifold absolute pressure (MAP) sensor electrical connector (3). 2. Remove the MAP sensor retaining clip (2) from the intake manifold. 3. Remove the MAP sensor (1) from the intake manifold. Installation Procedure Important: Lightly coat the MAP sensor seal with clean engine oil before installing the sensor. Page 3797 Open the harness by removing any tape. 2. Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. 3. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 4. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent american wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 5. Slide a section of high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing down the length of wire to be spliced. Ensure that the shrink tubing will not interfere with the splice procedure. 6. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 7. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. 8. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 9. Insert the wire into the DuraSeal splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 10. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Page 5592 2. Use a small flat-bladed tool to release the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting the tool in the small recess on the side of the connector and pushing up until the TPA releases from the connector body. The TPA should raise just slightly. Do not try to remove the TPA. IMPORTANT: The TPA on this connector cannot be removed unless the terminals are removed first. The TPA will come out of the connector body, but only slightly. When the TPA is slightly raised the terminals can be removed. Using excessive force to remove the TPA with the terminals still in the connector will damage the connector. 3. Repeat the process for the other side of the connector. 4. Ensure that the TPA is in the proper position to remove the terminals. Page 5400 Page 3868 Lifter / Lash Adjuster: Service and Repair Valve Lifter Replacement Valve Lifter Replacement Tools Required J 3049-A Valve Lifter Remover Removal Procedure 1. Remove the cylinder head and gasket. Refer to Cylinder Head Replacement - Left Side or to Cylinder Head Replacement - Right Side. 2. Remove the valve lifter. Refer to Valve Lifter Removal. 3. Clean and inspect the valve lifters. Refer to Valve Lifters and Guides Cleaning and Inspection. Installation Procedure Page 2594 pulling it through. This will prevent damage to the internal seals of the connector. Once the terminal is pushed out of the connector, cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible and pull the wire through the connector. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE The Micro-Pack 100W connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool was developed to crimp Micro-Pack 100W terminals. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 2. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert the terminal into the crimp tool until the core wings are flush with the anvil on the crimp tool. Be sure that the wings are pointed toward the crimp tool former and release the spring locator. The locator will hold the terminal in place. Inspect the alignment of the terminal wings with the crimp tool former. If the terminal wings are wider than the crimp tool former, remove the terminal and bend the terminal wings in slightly. 5. Place stripped wire into terminal. 6. Crimp the new terminal to the wire. If a jam occurs, press the emergency release to open applicator. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire perform the following procedure in order to replace Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. Page 3066 Disclaimer Page 817 vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide variety of actions, including: - Wiggling the harness - Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting - Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector - Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation - Relocating a harness or wires All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. Another option is, with the component commanded ON and OFF by the scan tool, move related connectors and wiring and observe the component operation. With the engine running, move related connectors and wiring while monitoring engine operation. If harness or connector movement affects the data displayed, component/system operation, or engine operation, inspect and repair the harness/connections as necessary. You may need to load the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these cases you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide good results as well. There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions, along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the circuit to these kinds of conditions. SALT WATER SPRAY Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture. Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5 percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously. HIGH TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070. Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault condition. The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis. This option does not allow for the same control, however. LOW TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect. If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to -18°C (0°F) from one end and +71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized cooling needs. Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or components in an effort to duplicate the concern. DUPLICATING FAILURE CONDITIONS - If none of the previous tests are successful, attempt to duplicate and/or capture the failure conditions. Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, where applicable, contains the conditions that were present when the DTC set. 1. Review and record Freeze Frame/Failure Records data. 2. Clear the DTCs using the scan tool. 3. Turn the key to OFF and wait 15 seconds. 4. Operate the vehicle under the same conditions that were noted in Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, as closely as possible. The vehicle must also be operating within the Conditions for Running the DTC. Refer to Conditions for Running the DTC in the supporting text if a DTC is being diagnosed. 5. Monitor DTC Status for the DTC being tested. The scan tool will indicate Ran, when the enabling conditions have been satisfied long enough for the DTC to run. The scan tool will also indicate whether the DTC passed or failed. - An alternate method is to drive the vehicle with the DMM connected to a suspected circuit. An abnormal reading on the DMM when the concern occurs, may help you locate the concern. Measuring Frequency Page 5876 Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size. REPAIRING A FUSIBLE LINK IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient overload protection. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. Flat Wire Repairs FLAT WIRE REPAIRS NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced. GMLAN Wiring Repairs GMLAN WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The GM Local Area Network (GMLAN) System requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working on GMLAN connectors and terminals. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items in order to repair the GMLAN wiring: Dura Seal splice sleeves - A wire stripping tool - J 38125-8 Crimping Tool (GM P/N 12085115) - J 38125-5 Ultra Torch Special Tool (GM P/N 12085116) The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. - A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors GMLAN REPAIRS IMPORTANT: When making a repair to any GMLAN network, the original wire length after the repair must be the same length as before the repair. If the network is a twisted pair, the twist must be maintained after the repair is completed. GMLAN has 2 types of networks, low speed and high speed. Low speed GMLAN has a single wire and works at slow speeds. High speed GMLAN has 2 wires in a twisted pair and works at higher speeds. For more information on GMLAN, refer to Data Link Communications Description and Operation. GMLAN CONNECTOR TERMINAL REPAIR IMPORTANT: A service terminal can be used to replace damaged connector terminals for both high speed and low speed GMLAN systems. When making a connector terminal repair on a GMLAN high speed system with twisted pair wires, do not untwist the wires more than necessary to make the repair. The terminals in the GMLAN system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are available in the J-38125. If the individual terminals are damaged on any GMLAN connection, use the appropriate connector repair procedure in order to repair the terminal. GMLAN WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 5968 Depress the locks that are located on both sides of the wiredress cover and pull the lever over and past the locks. View of the connector when released from the component. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the front of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool push down on one of the locking tabs and pull the cover up until the dress cover releases. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. Locations Camshaft Position Sensor: Locations Engine Controls Component Views Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor 1 - Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor 2 - C110 Page 6232 4. Use a small flat-blade tool to slide the terminal position assurance (TPA) up one notch on both ends of the connector. The TPA is located underneath the wire dress cover. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 8190 2. Use a small flat-bladed tool to release the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting the tool in the small recess on the side of the connector and pushing up until the TPA releases from the connector body. The TPA should raise just slightly. Do not try to remove the TPA. IMPORTANT: The TPA on this connector cannot be removed unless the terminals are removed first. The TPA will come out of the connector body, but only slightly. When the TPA is slightly raised the terminals can be removed. Using excessive force to remove the TPA with the terminals still in the connector will damage the connector. 3. Repeat the process for the other side of the connector. 4. Ensure that the TPA is in the proper position to remove the terminals. Page 7488 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. 4. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front of the connector. Page 8813 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Ensure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the Terminal Removal Procedure. Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PULL TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL If the terminal is visibly damaged or is suspected of having a faulty connection, the terminal should be replaced. Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors: 1. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) device and/or the secondary lock. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component or separate the connectors for in-line connectors. 3. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device. 4. Insert the proper pick or removal tool into the front of the connector body. 5. IMPORTANT: On connectors with more than one terminal the service loop may not be large enough to remove the terminal and crimp on a new one. If the terminal wire does not have a large enough service loop for removal, cut the wire 5 cm (2 in) behind the connector before removal. Grasp the wire at the back of the connector body and gently push the terminal out the front of the connector body. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. If the wire needed to be cut in order to remove the terminal, gently push a small length of the same size wire through the back of the connector cavity until there is enough wire exposed in order to crimp on a new terminal. If the wire was not cut, cut the existing wire as close to the old terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 4. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. TERMINAL INSTALLATION 1. Align the terminal and pull the wire from the back of the connector in order to seat the terminal. 2. If necessary, cut the new wire to proper length and splice with existing circuit. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. 3. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply dielectric grease to the connector. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PUSH TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 5375 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches, and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original. - The wires insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the possibility of fuel contact. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1). 5. Select the proper duraseal splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool. Refer to the Crimp and Seal Splice Table. 6. Place the duraseal splice sleeve in the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115) crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 7. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to hold the duraseal splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 8. Insert the wires into the duraseal splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel in order to prevent the wire from passing through the splice (3). 9. Close the handles of the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115), until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is applied to the splice sleeve. 10. Shrink the insulation around the splice. - Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. - Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Splicing Inline Harness Diodes SPLICING INLINE HARNESS DIODES Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure. 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode. 2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool. 5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode. Page 747 3. Ensure that the terminal release tang access panel is in the correct location to access the terminals. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) into the terminal release tang access slot located behind the access panel of the connector and press down on the terminal while carefully pulling the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Tyco/AMP Connectors (0.25 Cap) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (025 CAP) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component by pressing down on the connector position assurance (CPA). Page 5799 Checking Aftermarket Accessories CHECKING AFTERMARKET ACCESSORIES Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits: - CAUTION: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol. - NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice. OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol. Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the cause of the problems. Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include: Power feeds connected to points other than the battery - Antenna location - Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring - Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line - Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories. Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions INDUCING INTERMITTENT FAULT CONDITIONS TOOLS REQUIRED J 25070 Heat Gun Many intermittent open or shorted circuits are affected by harness/connector movement that is caused by vibration, engine torque, bumps/rough pavement, etc. In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness if the malfunction appears to be Page 679 Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Page 479 Release the tabs that are holding the wiredress cover to the connector body. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the slots on both ends of the connector body. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. J 38125-216 can also be used to remove the nose piece. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by lifting the terminal retaining tabs on the inside of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 1308 Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids Arrows and Symbols Arrows and Symbols This Service Data uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations. Arrows and Symbols 1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow Basic Knowledge Required GENERAL ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures contained in the service manual. You should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current (amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram, as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. Decimal and Metric Equivalents Decimal and Metric Equivalents Page 7321 Page 5568 REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. The release tab is located on the top of the wiredress cover. View of connector in released position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Page 5553 View of the connector when released from the component. View of another type of Micro 64 connector. Page 4596 3. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. View showing depressing of the lever lock release tab. Page 5595 View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. View of the release tool being used for the smaller terminals. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (2-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 842 - Most Molex connectors will have the Molex logo on the dresscover of the connector. In some cases the connectors may have MX followed by another letter. The third letter indicates where the connector was made. A connector with MXD is a Molex connector made in Detroit. Sumitomo has a unique symbol on their connector and possibly a part number. The symbol is similar to that of a diamond lying on its side, similar to that shown. The logo could appear anywhere but the most common place is at the wire side of the housing. Tyco/AMP has many different and unique connector designs. Some may or may not have identifiable marks on them. Page 7100 6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias. Reference the appropriate service manual wiring schematic to obtain the correct diode installation position. 7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for the soldering equipment. 8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed. 9. IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode attachment points with tape. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape. Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable SPLICING TWISTED OR SHIELDED CABLE Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable. 1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splice is made. 3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire. Staggering the splices by 65 mm (2.5 in) is recommended. 4. IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical contact with the drain wire. Re-assemble the cable. Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape. - Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1). - Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire. - Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape. Page 396 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) and slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. Specifications Spark Plug: Specifications Spark Plug Gap ................................................................................................................................... ...................................................... 1.02 mm (0.040in) Spark Plug Torque ......................................... ............................................................................................................................................. 15 N.m (11 lb ft) Page 1995 Depress the locks that are located on both sides of the wiredress cover and pull the lever over and past the locks. View of the connector when released from the component. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the front of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool push down on one of the locking tabs and pull the cover up until the dress cover releases. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. Page 2128 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) and slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. Page 234 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Engine/Transmission - Aftermarket Calibrations Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine/Transmission - Aftermarket Calibrations INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 09-06-04-026C Date: August 13, 2010 Subject: Identifying Non-GM (Aftermarket) Engine and Transmission Calibrations for V8 Gas Engines Using Tech 2(R) or Global Diagnostic System (GDS) Models: 2006-2011 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Excluding Saab 9-7X) 2006-2009 HUMMER H2 2006-2010 HUMMER H3 Equipped with V8 Gas Powered Engines Only Attention: This bulletin applies to V8 gas powered engines ONLY. For Duramax(TM) diesel powered engines, refer to the latest version of Corporate Bulletin Number 08-06-04-006G. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2011 model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 09-06-04-026A (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). General Motors is identifying an increasing number of engine, transmission and catalytic converter part failures that are the result of non-GM (aftermarket) engine and transmission control calibrations being used. When alteration to the GM-released engine or transmission control calibrations occurs, it subjects powertrain and driveline components (engine , transmission, transfer case, driveshaft and rear axle) to stresses that were not tested by General Motors. It is because of these unknown stresses, and the potential to alter reliability, durability and emissions performance, that GM has adopted a policy that prevents any UNAUTHORIZED dealer warranty claim submissions to any remaining warranty coverage, to the powertrain and driveline components whenever the presence of a non-GM (aftermarket) calibration is confirmed - even if the non-GM control module calibration is subsequently removed. Warranty coverage is based on the equipment and calibrations that were released on the vehicle at time of sale, or subsequently updated by GM. That's because GM testing and validation matches the calibration to a host of criteria that is essential to assure reliability, durability and emissions performance over the life of the warranty coverage and beyond. Stresses resulting from calibrations different from those tested and released by GM can damage or weaken components, leading to poor performance and or shortened life. Additionally, non-GM (aftermarket) issued engine control modifications often do not meet the same emissions performance standards as GM issued calibrations. Depending on state statutes, individuals who install engine control module calibrations that put the vehicle outside the parameters of emissions certification standards may be subject to fines and/or penalties. This bulletin outlines a procedure to identify the presence of non-GM (aftermarket) calibrations. GM recommends performing this check whenever a hard part failure is seen on internal engine or transmission components, or before an engine assembly or transmission assembly is being replaced under warranty. It is also recommended that the engine calibration verification procedure be performed whenever diagnostics indicate that catalytic converter replacement is indicated. The PQC has a process to confirm the ECM/PCM calibration is GM issued. The PQC will require a picture of the engine calibration verification screen, as outlined in this bulletin, before authorizing any V8 gas powered engine replacement. If a non-GM calibration is found and verification has taken place through GM, the remaining powertrain and driveline warranty will be blocked and notated in GMVIS and the dealership will be notified. This block prevents any UNAUTHORIZED warranty claim submission. 1. Connect the Tech 2(R) to the vehicle. 2. Go to: Diagnostics and build the vehicle. 3. Select: Powertrain. 4. Select: Engine. 5. *Select: Engine Control Module or PCM. 6. *Select: Module ID Information or I/M Information System if the Module ID Information selection is not available. 7. *If "I/M information System" was selected, it may be necessary to select "Vehicle Information" in order to display the calibration information. ‹› If the CVN information is displayed as "N/A", it will be necessary to contact the TCSC to obtain the CVN information. Page 5042 Important: Do not apply sealant to the first 3 threads of the bolt. 1. Apply a 5 mm (0.2 in) wide band of threadlock GM P/N 12345493 (Canadian P/N 10953488), or equivalent to the threads of the exhaust manifold bolts. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Install the exhaust manifold NEW gasket and bolts. 1. Tighten the bolts a first pass to 15 N.m (11 lb ft). Tighten the bolts beginning with the center 2 bolts. Alternate from side-to-side, and work toward the outside bolts. 2. Tighten the bolts a final pass to 25 N.m (18 lb ft). Tighten the bolts beginning with the center 2 bolts. Alternate from side-to-side, and work toward the outside bolts. 3. Install the heat shield, and bolts to the exhaust manifold. Tighten the bolts to 9 N.m (80 lb in). 4. Using a flat punch, bend over the exposed edge of the exhaust manifold gasket at the front of the right cylinder head. 5. Install the spark plugs. Refer to Spark Plug Replacement for the 5.3L engine or Spark Plug Replacement for the 6.0L engine. 6. Raise the vehicle. 7. Install the nuts that secure the catalytic converter to the left exhaust manifold. Tighten the nuts to 50 N.m (37 lb ft). 8. Lower the vehicle. Page 7483 3. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. View showing depressing of the lever lock release tab. Page 4845 2. Use a small flat-bladed tool to release the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting the tool in the small recess on the side of the connector and pushing up until the TPA releases from the connector body. The TPA should raise just slightly. Do not try to remove the TPA. IMPORTANT: The TPA on this connector cannot be removed unless the terminals are removed first. The TPA will come out of the connector body, but only slightly. When the TPA is slightly raised the terminals can be removed. Using excessive force to remove the TPA with the terminals still in the connector will damage the connector. 3. Repeat the process for the other side of the connector. 4. Ensure that the TPA is in the proper position to remove the terminals. Page 1912 6. Gently pry the plastic terminal retainer down and carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (16-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, pull the two connector halves apart. Page 6341 Release the lower wiredress cover locking tab. Release the upper wiredress cover locking tab. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. Page 5694 4. Once the front 2 locks are unlocked, lift the front of the dress cover and pull it forward. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the small slot on the TPA and pushing down until the TPA releases. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to angle or rock the J 38125-21 tool when inserting it into the connector or the tool may break. Insert the J 38125-21 (GM P/N 15381651-2) tool into the round canal between the terminals cavities at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to repair Micro 64 connector terminals. The Micro 64 connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-64 (M jaw) was developed to crimp Micro 64 terminals. The J 38125-64 crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. The J 38125-64 crimping tool is also designed to crimp both the wire and the insulation at the same time. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro 64 terminals. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. 1. Cut the wire as close to the damaged terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. Page 182 to analyze the data during the time a vehicle condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a trigger point that you have determined. Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2 snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a first-in, first-out basis. If a third snapshot is taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost. Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types: Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice - Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200 frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not lost if the Scan Tool is powered down. The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis. The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected values by plotting 3 parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful, especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC. Testing for a Short to Voltage TESTING FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4. Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt, there is a short to voltage in the circuit. Testing for Continuity TESTING FOR CONTINUITY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6. Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit. 7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity. With a Test Lamp IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits. 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6. If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity. Testing for Electrical Intermittents TESTING FOR ELECTRICAL INTERMITTENTS Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment. - Testing for Short to Ground - Testing for Continuity - Testing for a Short to Voltage Page 4030 11. Tighten the engine mount nuts. Tighten the nuts to 50 N.m (37 lb ft). 12. Install the shock module. Refer to Shock Module Replacement. 13. Install the engine protection shield. Refer to Engine Protection Shield Replacement. 14. Install the front tire and wheels. Refer to Tire and Wheel Removal and Installation. 15. Lower the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. Page 3470 Fuse Block - Underhood C8 Page 5409 Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Page 2218 5. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove TPA from the connector. 6. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Page 6273 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link). - The wire insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. 5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold them between thumb and forefinger. 7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place. - Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction. - Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip. 8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool closes.Ensure that no strands of wire are cut. 10. Crimp the splice on each end (2). Page 8893 MEASURING FREQUENCY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal. IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM to autorange to an appropriate range. 1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency measured. Measuring Voltage MEASURING VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit. 1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods: - Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. - Turn ON the engine. - Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls. - Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested. 3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The DMM displays the voltage measured at that point. Measuring Voltage Drop MEASURING VOLTAGE DROP NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points. Probing Electrical Connectors PROBING ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS Page 2915 Spark Plug: Testing and Inspection Spark Plug Inspection * Verify that the correct spark plug is installed. An incorrect spark plug causes driveability conditions. Refer to Ignition System Specifications for the correct spark plug. * Ensure that the spark plug has the correct heat range. An incorrect heat range causes the following conditions: - Spark plug fouling - Colder plug - Pre-ignition causing spark plug and/or engine damage - Hotter plug * Inspect the terminal post (1) for damage. - Inspect for a bent or broken terminal post (1) - Test for a loose terminal post (1) by twisting and pulling the post. The terminal post should not move. * Inspect the insulator (2) for flashover or carbon tracking, or soot. This is caused by the electrical charge traveling across the insulator between the terminal post (1) and ground. Inspect for the following conditions: - Inspect the spark plug boot for damage. - Inspect the spark plug recess are of the cylinder head for moisture, such as oil, coolant, or water. A spark plug boot that is saturated will cause arcing to ground. * Inspect the insulator (2) for cracks. All or part of the electrical charge may arc through the crack instead of the electrodes (3,4). Page 7957 5. Remove paint and primer from the area surrounding the 10 mm (0.40 in) until bare metal is visible. Important The M6 conductive rivet stud as shown, can accommodate a panel thickness range of 0.7-4.2 mm (0.03-0.17 in). If there are layers of sheet metal, they should be touching without any air gaps to ensure a good ground. 6. Select a M6 conductive rivet stud. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. Note Use the GE-50317 rivet stud tool kit. 7. Place the M6 conductive rivet stud (1) in the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole. Assemble the rivet stud tool (2) with the groove and flare side facing the rivet stud, then the washer and the M6 nut (3). 8. Using a wrench on the rivet stud tool, and a socket on the M6 nut, secure the M6 conductive rivet stud. 9. Ensure the new rivet stud is securely fastened, WITHOUT ANY detectable movement. 10. Completely wrap the threads of the rivet stud with painters tape or equivalent. Page 7387 7. The illustration above identifies the entry canal where the terminal release tool will be inserted, and the terminal cavity. - Terminal (1) - Entry Canal (2) 8. Insert the J-38125-553 (15315247) tool into the entry canal and pry up on the terminal retainer. The terminal retainer is a small plastic piece on the top of the terminal. The terminal retainer must be held up while the terminal is pulled out of the connector. Page 4892 to analyze the data during the time a vehicle condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a trigger point that you have determined. Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2 snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a first-in, first-out basis. If a third snapshot is taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost. Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types: Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice - Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200 frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not lost if the Scan Tool is powered down. The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis. The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected values by plotting 3 parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful, especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC. Testing for a Short to Voltage TESTING FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4. Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt, there is a short to voltage in the circuit. Testing for Continuity TESTING FOR CONTINUITY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6. Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit. 7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity. With a Test Lamp IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits. 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6. If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity. Testing for Electrical Intermittents TESTING FOR ELECTRICAL INTERMITTENTS Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment. - Testing for Short to Ground - Testing for Continuity - Testing for a Short to Voltage Page 33 * Dealers using WINs: Add 0.2 hours to the labor time for administrative allowance for the module exchange. Dealers using GWM: Submit 0.2 hours administrative allowance under "Administration Time" for the module exchange. ** The $25 represents the additional net amount allowed for the module exchange. *** Dealers are to claim only administrative allowance of 0.2 hours when the module is replaced by Masscomp's Mobile Unit. Dealers using WINS should submit the 0.2 hours administrative allowance in labor time. Dealer using GWM should submit the 0.2 hours administrative allowance under Administrative Time. Customer Notification OnStar will notify customers of this program on their vehicle. Dealer Program Responsibility All unsold new vehicles in dealers'/retailers' possession and subject to this program must be held and inspected/repaired per the service procedure of this program bulletin before customers take possession of these vehicles. Dealers/retailers are to service all vehicles subject to this program at no charge to customers, regardless of mileage, age of vehicle, or ownership, through April 30, 2011. Customers who have recently purchased vehicles sold from your vehicle inventory, and for which there is no customer information indicated on the dealer/retailer listing, are to be contacted by the dealer/retailer. Arrangements are to be made to make the required correction according to the instructions contained in this bulletin. A copy of the customer letter is provided in this bulletin for your use in contacting customers. Program follow-up cards should not be used for this purpose, since the customer may not as yet have received the notification letter. Page 6785 Disclaimer Page 4119 7. Wrap electrical tape around the connection as shown. 8. Route the engine coolant heater cord and extension cord behind the alternator and adjacent to the engine coolant crossover pipe as shown. 9. Continue to route the extension cord to the exit location desired by the customer as shown. 10. Review the routing of the coolant heater cord and extension cord to verify that it does not touch any sharp edges that could damage it. 11. Secure the engine coolant heater cord and the extension cord with tie straps as needed. 12. Resecure any of the original clips that retained the engine coolant heater cord to the vehicle that were released to provide length. Part Information The extension cord may be obtained at any of the following outlets: - Lowes* - Home Depot* - Canada: Acklands-Grainger* (www.acklandsgrainger.com), Catalogue Part Number: CWRSJTOW3C14-10 USA: Cords should bear the UL symbol. Canada: Cords should bear the ULc symbol or CSA approval. *We believe these sources and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume any responsibility for the products or material from these firms or for any such items that may be available from other sources. Page 8092 5. Insert the ECM into the retaining slots of the ECM/TCM bracket. 6. Secure the ECM to the bracket ensuring that the ECM retaining tabs (1) are fully engaged. 7. Connect the engine wiring harness electrical connectors to the ECM. Page 5351 2. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 4491 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. 4. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front of the connector. Page 8975 If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the DuraSeal splice sleeves. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: - Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. - Do not use the crimp and DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 to crimp DuraSeal splice sleeve. In order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 7201 4. Slide the dress cover forward and off of the connector. 5. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front and rear of the connector. Page 4773 All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system. Page 7696 Page 1792 Page 1649 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the DuraSeal splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of a connector. CPAs are used in all SIR System connectors and also in some connectors of other systems. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals of a connection. TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE CLIPS IMPORTANT: When making a splice in an area that may be exposed to moisture use a crimp and seal splice sleeve instead of a Splice Clip. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. Page 1741 Release the lower wiredress cover locking tab. Release the upper wiredress cover locking tab. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. Page 5580 8. Insert the J 38125-213 into the small terminal release hole on the nose piece and gently pull on the back of the wire. 9. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Repairing Connector Terminals REPAIRING CONNECTOR TERMINALS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following: Push to Seat terminals - Pull to Seat terminals Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your terminal repair. The J-38125 contains further information. 1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.For cable seal terminals, remove the seal. 2. Apply the correct cable seal per gage size of the wire, if used.Slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation removal. 3. Remove the insulation. 4. For sealed terminals only, align the seal with the end of the cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal.For sealed terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal. 6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.For sealed terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable. 8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals excepting Micro-Pack 100.64 size. Soldering Micro-Pack 100 World terminals may damage the terminal. Sumitomo Connectors SUMITOMO CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Diagram Information and Instructions Knock Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions Electrical Symbols Page 1627 7. Pressing the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool in the release cavity of the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and crimper in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (DOOR MODULE) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Side view of connector. View of top of connector. 1. Locate the assist lever and lock on the top of the connector. Page 4551 breakers are used. CIRCUIT BREAKER This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high current is removed. POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) CIRCUIT BREAKER This type greatly increases its resistance when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker will re-close within a second or 2. Circuit Protection - Fuses CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSES The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and examine the element in the fuse for an open (2). If not broken (1), also check for continuity using a DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one of equal current rating. Circuit Protection - Fusible Links CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSIBLE LINKS Page 7761 Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. For connectors with a bolt in the dress cover, turn the bolt counterclockwise to remove the connector from the component. 2. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. Page 743 7. Pressing the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool in the release cavity of the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and crimper in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (DOOR MODULE) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Side view of connector. View of top of connector. 1. Locate the assist lever and lock on the top of the connector. Page 2048 If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs SIR/SRS WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS, and the wiring components, such as connectors and terminals. IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system terminals. Use either an SIR/SRS pigtail or a terminated lead from the SIR Repair Kit Tray. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves, in order to repair the SIR/SRS wiring - A special crimping tool - A heat torch - An instruction manual The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides the necessary low resistance contact integrity for these sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors SIR/SRS CONNECTOR REPAIR (PLASTIC BODY AND TERMINAL METAL PIN) The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made with a special plating. This plating provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. Use the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit for repairing SIR/SRS terminals and connectors. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the repair kit. The J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit contains: Various terminated leads for sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) terminal replacement - Various connector positive assurance (CPA) locks for SIR/SRS connectors - Base of steering column pigtail connectors part number 12085514 - Yellow vinyl electrical tape Pigtail repair packs are available for SIR/SRS connectors with eight or less terminals. Only the connector body is available for connectors with more than eight terminals. The terminated leads in the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit can be used to replace damaged terminals when replacing the connector body. SIR/SRS COMPONENT WIRE PIGTAIL REPAIR IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails. A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device, not by a connector. If a wiring pigtail is damaged, you must replace the entire component, with pigtail. The inflatable restraint steering wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component. SIR/SRS WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 733 MOLEX CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. 2. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. Page 7513 Release the lower wiredress cover locking tab. Release the upper wiredress cover locking tab. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. Page 3377 - Most Molex connectors will have the Molex logo on the dresscover of the connector. In some cases the connectors may have MX followed by another letter. The third letter indicates where the connector was made. A connector with MXD is a Molex connector made in Detroit. Sumitomo has a unique symbol on their connector and possibly a part number. The symbol is similar to that of a diamond lying on its side, similar to that shown. The logo could appear anywhere but the most common place is at the wire side of the housing. Tyco/AMP has many different and unique connector designs. Some may or may not have identifiable marks on them. Page 1830 Page 5767 Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair Fuel Sender Assembly Replacement Fuel Sender Assembly Replacement Tools Required J45722 Fuel Tank Sending Unit Wrench Removal Procedure 1. Remove the fuel tank. 2. Remove the fuel feed (1) and EVAP (2) lines from the fuel sender assembly. Notice: Avoid damaging the lock ring. Use only J-45722 to prevent damage to the lock ring. Notice: Do Not handle the fuel sender assembly by the fuel pipes. The amount of leverage generated by handling the fuel pipes could damage the joints. Important: Do NOT use impact tools. Significant force will be required to release the lock ring. The use of a hammer and screwdriver is not recommended. Secure the fuel tank in order to prevent fuel tank rotation. 3. Use the J45722 and a long breaker-bar in order to unlock the fuel sender lock ring. Turn the fuel sender lock ring in a counterclockwise direction. Page 5349 3. Use a small flat-bladed tool to gently pry off the dress cover by inserting the tool under the cover opposite the harness side and prying up. 4. Remove the cover. 5. Using a small flat-bladed tool, push on the side of the nose piece retainer while pushing the nose piece forward with your thumb. This will release the terminal position assurance (TPA). 6. Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) into the corresponding terminal release cavity. The release cavities are the 2 center rows of cavities on one half of the connector. Page 6947 6. Gently pry the plastic terminal retainer down and carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (16-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, pull the two connector halves apart. Page 7292 Remove all rust from the ground terminal, the cylinder head and the retaining nut or bolt. Position the main engine wiring harness ground terminal and install the nut or bolt. Tighten: Tighten the retaining nut or bolt to 16 N.m (12 lb ft). Apply some type of electrical moisture sealant to protect the harness terminal from further corrosion. Disclaimer Page 3647 service operation. A simple distraction or time constraint that rushes the job may result in personal injury if the greatest of care is not exercised. Make it a habit to double check your work and to always side with caution when installing wheels. Disclaimer Page 6062 Page 8890 Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Page 4260 1. Ignition OFF, relieve the fuel pressure. Refer to Fuel Pressure Relief. 2. Install the J37287 between the fuel feed pipe and the fuel rail. 3. Open the valve on the J37287. 4. Ignition ON, command the fuel pump relay ON with a scan tool and bleed the air from the fuel pressure gage. 5. Close the valve on the J37287. 6. Verify that the fuel pressure does not decrease more than 34 kPa (5 psi) in 1 minute. ‹› If the fuel pressure drops, locate and replace the leaking fuel injector. 7. If the fuel system test normal, replace the fuel pump. * Relieve the fuel pressure to 69 kPa (10 psi). Verify that the fuel pressure does not decrease more than 14 kPa (2 psi) in 5 minutes. ‹› If the fuel pressure decreases more than the specified value, replace the fuel pump. * Remove the J37287 and J34730-1A. * Operate the vehicle within the conditions of the customers concern while monitoring the fuel trim and O2 parameters with a scan tool. The scan tool parameters should not indicate a lean condition. ‹› If the scan tool parameters indicate a lean condition, test for a restricted fuel feed pipe, restricted fuel filter, or poor connections at the harness connectors and ground circuits of the fuel pump. If all test normal, replace the fuel pump. * If the fuel system components test normal, refer to Symptoms - Engine Controls. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures/Symptoms - Engine Controls Repair Instructions Perform the Diagnostic Repair Verification after completing the diagnostic procedure. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests and Procedures * Fuel Injector Replacement * Fuel Sender Assembly Replacement Page 6685 View of a typical Micro 64 connector. Depress the lock and pull the lever over and past the lock. Page 5459 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Kostal Connectors KOSTAL CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 2131 Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. FCI Connectors FCI CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 1316 to analyze the data during the time a vehicle condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a trigger point that you have determined. Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2 snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a first-in, first-out basis. If a third snapshot is taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost. Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types: Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice - Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200 frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not lost if the Scan Tool is powered down. The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis. The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected values by plotting 3 parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful, especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC. Testing for a Short to Voltage TESTING FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4. Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt, there is a short to voltage in the circuit. Testing for Continuity TESTING FOR CONTINUITY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6. Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit. 7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity. With a Test Lamp IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits. 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6. If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity. Testing for Electrical Intermittents TESTING FOR ELECTRICAL INTERMITTENTS Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment. - Testing for Short to Ground - Testing for Continuity - Testing for a Short to Voltage Page 8441 6. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by pressing on the tang. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (SENSOR) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) tool into the cavity on the lower right hand face of the connector until the terminal release tang access panel slides over. Page 3259 - JST connectors have JST in small letters on their connectors, similar to that above. The location of the logo will vary with the connector size and style. - Kostel has an "LK" with a circle around it. These connector are usually used as a transmissions connection and are currently use on some Cadillac vehicles. Page 8698 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully raise the TPA on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA cannot be removed from the connector while there are terminals present in the connector body. View of the TPA when removed from the connector body. 4. Use the J 38125-12A tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the left side of the terminal release cavity as shown in the graphic. Use the tool to move the terminal release to the right with a gentle prying motion. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 5380 Page 3373 Connector Anatomy Connector Repairs contains a list of all connector repairs. The connector repairs are listed by the connector manufacturer and then by connector type. If the technician cannot identify the manufacturer of the connector, refer to Identifying Connectors below. Knowing the connector manufacturer will assist in finding the correct connector repair from the following list: - Connector Position Assurance Locks - Terminal Position Assurance Locks - Bosch Connectors (0.64) Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) Bosch Connectors (BSK) Bosch Connectors (ECM) - Delphi Connectors (Micro.64) Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) Delphi Connectors (12-Way) - Tyco/AMP Connectors (CM 42-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) Tyco/AMP Connectors (025 Cap) Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) - Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) - Repairing Connector Terminals IDENTIFYING CONNECTORS Knowing the connector manufacturer is helpful when trying to locating the correct connector repair procedure. There are many different connector designs used on GM vehicles and it is sometimes difficult to identify the connector manufacturer. The information in this document should help with the identification of connector manufactures. The following connector manufacturers make most of the connectors found in GM vehicles: AFL/EPC (Alcoa Fujikura Ltd./Engineered Plastics Components) - Bosch - Delphi - FCI (Framatome Connectors International) - JAE (Japan Aviation Electronics) - JST (Japan Solderless Terminals) Page 4866 6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias. Reference the appropriate service manual wiring schematic to obtain the correct diode installation position. 7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for the soldering equipment. 8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed. 9. IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode attachment points with tape. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape. Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable SPLICING TWISTED OR SHIELDED CABLE Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable. 1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splice is made. 3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire. Staggering the splices by 65 mm (2.5 in) is recommended. 4. IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical contact with the drain wire. Re-assemble the cable. Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape. - Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1). - Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire. - Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape. Page 8846 Release the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the blue locking tabs on both ends of the connector. Gently slide the TPA up to the released position on both ends. 6. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-13A (GM P/N 12031876-1) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. Page 5476 6. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by pressing on the tang. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (SENSOR) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) tool into the cavity on the lower right hand face of the connector until the terminal release tang access panel slides over. OnStar(R) - Analog/Digital System Information Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Analog/Digital System Information INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 06-08-46-008C Date: September 18, 2008 Subject: Information on OnStar(R) Dual-Mode (Analog/Digital) Systems Models Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to correct the model year range for the Chevrolet Impala and Monte Carlo and update the reference to GM Dealerworld. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 06-08-46-008B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories). All 2000-2003 model year vehicles equipped with OnStar® from the list above were built with Analog/Digital-Ready OnStar(R) Hardware. Some of these vehicles may have been upgraded to Dual-Mode (Analog/Digital). Certain 2004-2005 model year vehicles equipped with OnStar(R) from the list above may have been either: ^ Originally built at the factory with Dual-Mode (Analog/Digital) OnStar(R) Hardware with Dual-Mode (Analog/Digital) OnStar(R) Hardware OR ^ Upgraded to Dual-Mode (Analog/Digital) Hardware All 2006 model year and newer vehicles equipped with OnStar(R) were built at the factory with Dual-Mode (Analog/Digital) OnStar(R) Hardware. If a vehicle has Dual-Mode (Analog/Digital) OnStar(R) Hardware, then the system is capable of operating on both the analog and digital cellular Page 8408 The first connector design of the Micro-Pack 100W (1) has a white connector interface that holds the terminals. The second design of the Micro-Pack 100W (2) has a gray interface to hold the terminals. Also, the first design has terminal cavities that are further apart (3 mm centerline) and offset from the other row of terminal cavities in the connector. The second design has terminals cavities that are closer together (2.54 mm centerline) and aligned vertically. One other way to identify the second design is the thin strip of material that runs along the outside of the cavities. IMPORTANT: There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W terminals which are very similar. Ensure that you have the correct terminal before crimping the new terminal to the wire. The first design connector uses the longer terminal (1) that has a raised area in front of the recess in the terminal. The second design connector uses the shorter terminal without the raised area. Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro-Pack 100W connectors. Some Micro-Pack 100W connector disassembly procedures will vary. Use this procedure as a guide. 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 6208 5. Insert the J 38125-557 (GM P/N 12122378) into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 6. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Connector Position Assurance Locks CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of the connector. CPAs are used in various connectors throughout the vehicle. CPAs are also used in all SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals, of the connector. Connector Repairs CONNECTOR REPAIRS Page 8310 2. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully push the terminal position assurance (TPA) towards the face of the connector on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA is fragile and may break if not done carefully. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. 3. Use the J 38125-215 tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 2309 Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids Arrows and Symbols Arrows and Symbols This Service Data uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations. Arrows and Symbols 1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow Basic Knowledge Required GENERAL ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures contained in the service manual. You should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current (amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram, as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. Decimal and Metric Equivalents Decimal and Metric Equivalents Page 6863 Page 7512 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) and slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. Page 8205 If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs SIR/SRS WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS, and the wiring components, such as connectors and terminals. IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system terminals. Use either an SIR/SRS pigtail or a terminated lead from the SIR Repair Kit Tray. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves, in order to repair the SIR/SRS wiring - A special crimping tool - A heat torch - An instruction manual The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides the necessary low resistance contact integrity for these sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors SIR/SRS CONNECTOR REPAIR (PLASTIC BODY AND TERMINAL METAL PIN) The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made with a special plating. This plating provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. Use the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit for repairing SIR/SRS terminals and connectors. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the repair kit. The J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit contains: Various terminated leads for sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) terminal replacement - Various connector positive assurance (CPA) locks for SIR/SRS connectors - Base of steering column pigtail connectors part number 12085514 - Yellow vinyl electrical tape Pigtail repair packs are available for SIR/SRS connectors with eight or less terminals. Only the connector body is available for connectors with more than eight terminals. The terminated leads in the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit can be used to replace damaged terminals when replacing the connector body. SIR/SRS COMPONENT WIRE PIGTAIL REPAIR IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails. A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device, not by a connector. If a wiring pigtail is damaged, you must replace the entire component, with pigtail. The inflatable restraint steering wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component. SIR/SRS WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Diagrams Tow Sensor: Diagrams Immobilizer Connector End Views Inclination Sensor (BAE) Page 895 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Start in the middle and gradually move the heat barrel to the open ends of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Heated Oxygen Sensor Wiring Repairs HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being obstructed. If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. - Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks, etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire. - Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance. - To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector. Page 472 If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200 DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J 39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected. IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J 39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and maximum (MAX) values measured. 1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of a suspected circuit to the other. 2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J 39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep). IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value in order to record the full change. 5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling the connections or the wiring, test driving, or performing other operations. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions. 6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9. Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist. Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections TESTING FOR INTERMITTENT CONDITIONS AND POOR CONNECTIONS TOOLS REQUIRED - J 35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit - J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit When the condition is not currently present, but is indicated in DTC history, the cause may be intermittent. An intermittent may also be the cause when there is a customer complaint, but the symptom cannot be duplicated. Refer to the Symptom Table of the system that is suspect of causing the condition before trying to locate an intermittent condition. Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the following items: Wiring broken inside the insulation - Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector - Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself, and corrosion in the wire to terminal contact area, etc. - Pierced or damaged insulation can allow moisture to enter the wiring causing corrosion. The conductor can corrode inside the insulation, with little visible evidence. Look for swollen and stiff sections of wire in the suspect circuits. - Wiring which has been pinched, cut, or its insulation rubbed through may cause an intermittent open or short as the bare area touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle. - Wiring that comes in contact with hot or exhaust components - Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required, in order to verify the customer concern. - Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. - Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis and Vehicle Data Recorder operation. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any inline connectors before replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation. Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination, usually in the underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit. Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper adapter. Always use the J 35616 when probing connectors. Other causes of terminal deformation are improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT IN BUSSED ELECTRICAL CENTERS (BEC) Page 8371 All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system. Page 6967 Page 8198 breakers are used. CIRCUIT BREAKER This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high current is removed. POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) CIRCUIT BREAKER This type greatly increases its resistance when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker will re-close within a second or 2. Circuit Protection - Fuses CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSES The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and examine the element in the fuse for an open (2). If not broken (1), also check for continuity using a DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one of equal current rating. Circuit Protection - Fusible Links CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSIBLE LINKS Page 5302 difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Bosch Connectors (ECM) BOSCH CONNECTORS (ECM) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the assist lever on the top of the connector. Move the assist lever to the forward position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Crankshaft Position Sensor Replacement Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Crankshaft Position Sensor Replacement Crankshaft Position Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure Important: Perform Crankshaft Position System Variation Learn whenever the crankshaft position (CKP) sensor is removed or replaced. 1. Remove the starter. 2. Disconnect the electrical connector (2) from the CKP sensor (1). 3. Clean the area around the CKP sensor before removal in order to avoid debris from entering the engine. 4. Remove the CKP sensor bolt. 5. Remove the CKP sensor. Installation Procedure Page 6917 Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. FCI Connectors FCI CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 7740 Page 6596 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert a small flat-blade tool in the slot below the front loaded terminal position assurance (TPA) and pry up. 3. Remove the TPA by pulling it out of the connector. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-553 (GM P/N 15315247) on a slight upward angle into the cavity below the terminal to be removed. Ensure that the pointed on the end of the tool is facing the bottom of the terminal and it stays in contact with the terminal until it stops on the plastic terminal retainer. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 1356 4. Use a small flat-blade tool to slide the terminal position assurance (TPA) up one notch on both ends of the connector. The TPA is located underneath the wire dress cover. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 5218 3. Ensure that the terminal release tang access panel is in the correct location to access the terminals. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) into the terminal release tang access slot located behind the access panel of the connector and press down on the terminal while carefully pulling the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Tyco/AMP Connectors (0.25 Cap) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (025 CAP) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component by pressing down on the connector position assurance (CPA). Page 2977 For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 8481 Important: Never reuse the old seal or a fuel leak may occur. Always use a NEW seal. 1. Install a NEW seal (3) onto the fuel tank. Important: Place the fuel pump strainer in a horizontal position when you install the fuel sender in the tank. When installing the fuel sender assembly, assure that the fuel pump strainer does not block full travel of the float arm. 2. Install the fuel sender assembly (2). Important: Always replace the fuel sender seal when installing the fuel sender assembly. Replace the lock ring if necessary. Do not apply any type of lubrication in the seal groove. Ensure the lock ring is installed with the correct side facing upward. A correctly installed lock ring will only turn in a clockwise direction. 3. Use the J45722 in order to install the fuel sender lock ring. Turn the fuel sender lock ring in a clockwise direction. Page 8564 MOLEX CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. 2. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. Page 2146 3. Remove the dress cover by using a flat-blade tool to release the connector locking tabs and pulling off the dress cover. 4. Relieve the tension on the nose piece retainers by inserting J-38125-12A (12094429) into the single retainer slot on the end of the nose piece and gently prying out the locking tab. Repeat the process for both of the nose piece locking tabs on the opposite side of the nose piece. Page 8418 Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. FCI Connectors FCI CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 8603 Engine - Valve Lifter Tick Noise At Start Up Engine Oil: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Valve Lifter Tick Noise At Start Up TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 10-06-01-007C Date: February 09, 2011 Subject: Active Fuel Management (AFM) Engine, Valve Lifter Tick Noise at Start Up When Engine Has Been Off for 2 Hours or More (Evaluate Noise and/or Replace Valve Lifters) Models: 2007 Buick Rainier 2009 Buick LaCrosse Super, Allure Super (Canada Only) 2007 Cadillac Escalade Built Prior to April 1, 2006 with 6.2L Engine RPO L92 (These engines were built with AFM Hardware but the AFM system was disabled) 2010-2011 Cadillac Escalade, Escalade ESV, Escalade EXT 2007 Chevrolet Monte Carlo 2007-2009 Chevrolet Impala 2007-2011 Chevrolet Avalanche, Silverado, Suburban, Tahoe, TrailBlazer, TrailBlazer EXT 2010-2011 Chevrolet Camaro SS 2007-2011 GMC Envoy, Envoy XL, Sierra, Yukon, Yukon Denali, Yukon XL, Yukon XL Denali 2007-2008 Pontiac Grand Prix 2008-2009 Pontiac G8 2007-2009 Saab 9-7X Equipped with AFM (Active Fuel Management) and V8 Engine RPO L76, L94, L99, LC9, LFA, LH6, LMG, LS4, LY5 or LZ1 Attention: This bulletin only applies to the AFM V8 engines listed above. It DOES NOT apply to Non-AFM Engines. If you are dealing with a Non-AFM engine that is experiencing a similar noise, please refer to Engine Mechanical > Diagnostic Information and Procedures > Symptoms in SI. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add models. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 10-06-01-007B (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). Condition Some customers may comment on an engine valve lifter tick noise that occurs after the engine has been shut off for at least two hours. The tick noise may last from two seconds to ten minutes. Cause This condition may be caused by any of the following: - Aerated oil in the valve lifter body, resulting in the valve lifter being unable to purge the air quickly. - A low engine oil level or incorrect oil viscosity. - Dirty or contaminated oil. - A low internal valve lifter oil reservoir level. - Debris in the valve lifter. - A high valve lifter leak down rate. Correction If the SI diagnostics do not isolate the cause of this valve lifter tick noise and normal oil pressure is noted during the concern, perform the following steps: 1. Inspect the engine oil condition and level. Refer to Owner Manual > Service and Appearance Care > Checking Things Under the Hood > Description and Operation > Engine Oil in SI. ‹› If the engine oil is more than one quart low, an incorrect oil viscosity is being used or if poor quality/contamination is observed, change the oil and filter. Note Page 4083 1. Install the displacement on demand oil pressure relief valve (455) by pushing upward until fully seated. 2. Install the oil filter tube (447). Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 3. Install the oil filter tube bolts (435, 446) and gaskets (445, 448). Tighten the bolts to 12 N.m (106 lb in). 4. Install the oil pan. Refer to Oil Pan Replacement. A/T - Key Will Not Release From Ignition Lock Cylinder Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Customer Interest A/T - Key Will Not Release From Ignition Lock Cylinder Bulletin No.: 05-07-30-021B Date: October 04, 2007 TECHNICAL Subject: Ignition Key Will Not Remove From Ignition Lock Cylinder (Reposition Shifter Boot) Models: 2004-2007 Buick Rainier 2002-2008 Chevrolet TrailBlazer Models 2002-2008 GMC Envoy Models 2003-2004 Oldsmobile Bravada Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to include the 2008 model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 05-07-30-021A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle). Condition Some customers may comment that they are unable to remove the ignition key from the ignition cylinder. Cause The shifter boot may be caught/trapped in the shifter assembly mechanism. Correction Inspect the shifter boot for being caught/trapped in the shifter assembly. If the shifter boot is NOT caught/trapped in the shift assembly, refer to Ignition Key Cannot Be Removed from the Ignition Lock Cylinder in SI. If the shifter boot IS caught/trapped in the shifter assembly, continue with the next step. DO NOT replace the complete shifter assembly for this condition. ONLY replace the shifter boot/handle if damaged by shifter assembly. Reposition the shifter boot so that it is not caught/trapped in the shifter assembly. Warranty Information Page 7501 View of the connector when released from the component. View of another type of Micro 64 connector. Page 3022 6. Lower the vehicle. 7. Fill the crankcase with the proper quantity and grade of engine oil. Refer to Approximate Fluid Capacities and to Fluid and Lubricant Recommendations. 8. Remove the oil level indicator. 9. Wipe the indicator with a clean cloth. 10. Install the oil level indicator. 11. Remove the oil level indicator in order to check the level. 12. Add oil if necessary. 13. Close the hood. Page 3536 Page 2236 7. Apply pressure and gently rock the cover until one locking leg is unseated. 8. Continue to apply pressure and rock the cover until the second locking leg is unseated. Repeat procedure for the other side of the dress cover and remove the cover. 9. Use J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) to gently lift the terminal retaining tab while gently pulling the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 10. If the terminal is severely bent or damaged, it may be possible on some connectors to push the wire out of the front of the connector instead of Page 3048 Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 3. Connect the evaporator tube to the evaporator (5). Tighten the nut to 28 N.m (21 lb ft). 4. Connect the auxiliary evaporator tube to the auxiliary piping. Tighten the nut to 28 N.m (21 lb ft). 5. Connect the evaporator tube to the condenser. Tighten the nut to 28 N.m (21 lb ft). 6. Install the coolant recovery tank. 7. Install the washer solvent container. 8. Install the nuts (1, 2) retaining the evaporator tube to the fender. Tighten the nuts to 28 N.m (21 lb ft). 9. Evacuate and recharge the A/C system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 10. Leak test the fittings of the components using the J39400-A. Page 6915 Release the lower wiredress cover locking tab. Release the upper wiredress cover locking tab. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. Page 1309 Page 1667 1. Install the fuel level sensor (2) and electrical connector (1) to the fuel sender assembly. 2. Connect the fuel level sensor electrical connector (1). 3. Ensure the fuel level sensor retaining tabs (2) are fully engaged. 4. Install the fuel sender assembly. Page 7431 Engine Control Module: Description and Operation Engine Control Module Description The powertrain has electronic controls to reduce exhaust emissions while maintaining excellent driveability and fuel economy. The engine control module (ECM) is the control center of this system. The ECM monitors numerous engine and vehicle functions. The ECM constantly monitors the information from various sensors and other inputs, and controls the systems that affect vehicle performance and emissions. The ECM also performs the diagnostic tests on various parts of the system. The ECM can recognize operational problems and alert the driver via the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL). When the ECM detects a malfunction, the ECM stores a diagnostic trouble code (DTC). The problem area is identified by the particular DTC that is set. The control module supplies a buffered voltage to various sensors and switches. Review the components and wiring diagrams in order to determine which systems are controlled by the ECM. Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) Operation The malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) is located in the instrument panel cluster. The MIL will display as either SERVICE ENGINE SOON or one of the following symbols when commanded ON: The MIL indicates that an emissions related fault has occurred and vehicle service is required. The following is a list of the modes of operation for the MIL: * The MIL illuminates when the ignition is turned ON, with the engine OFF. This is a bulb test to ensure the MIL is able to illuminate. * The MIL turns OFF after the engine is started if a diagnostic fault is not present. * The MIL remains illuminated after the engine is started if the control module detects a fault. A diagnostic trouble code (DTC) is stored any time the control module illuminates the MIL due to an emissions related fault. The MIL turns OFF after three consecutive ignition cycles in which a Test Passed has been reported for the diagnostic test that originally caused the MIL to illuminate. * The MIL flashes if the control module detects a misfire condition which could damage the catalytic converter. * When the MIL is illuminated and the engine stalls, the MIL will remain illuminated as long as the ignition is ON. * When the MIL is not illuminated and the engine stalls, the MIL will not illuminate until the ignition is cycled OFF and then ON. Underhood Fuse Block Fuse: Locations Underhood Fuse Block Fuse Block - Underhood (5.3L/6.0L), Label Page 8267 4. Once the front 2 locks are unlocked, lift the front of the dress cover and pull it forward. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the small slot on the TPA and pushing down until the TPA releases. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to angle or rock the J 38125-21 tool when inserting it into the connector or the tool may break. Insert the J 38125-21 (GM P/N 15381651-2) tool into the round canal between the terminals cavities at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to repair Micro 64 connector terminals. The Micro 64 connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-64 (M jaw) was developed to crimp Micro 64 terminals. The J 38125-64 crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. The J 38125-64 crimping tool is also designed to crimp both the wire and the insulation at the same time. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro 64 terminals. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. 1. Cut the wire as close to the damaged terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. Page 3873 Important: When reusing the valve train components, always install the components to the original location and position. The valve lash is net build, no valve adjustment is required. 1. Lubricate the valve rocker arms and pushrods with clean engine oil. 2. Lubricate the flange of the valve rocker arm bolts with clean engine oil. 3. Lubricate the flange or washer surface of the bolt that will contact the valve rocker arm. 4. Install the valve rocker arm pivot support. Important: Make sure that the pushrods seat properly to the valve lifter sockets. 5. Install the pushrods. Important: Verify that the pushrods seat properly to the ends of the rocker arms. DO NOT tighten the rocker arm bolts at this time. 6. Install the rocker arms and bolts. Page 6482 View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. View of the release tool being used for the smaller terminals. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (2-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 7572 Data Communication Diagram 2 Page 6753 Knock Sensor: Description and Operation Knock Sensor (KS) System Description Purpose The knock sensor (KS) system enables the control module to control the ignition timing for the best possible performance while protecting the engine from potentially damaging levels of detonation. The control module uses the KS system to test for abnormal engine noise that may indicate detonation, also known as spark knock. Sensor Description This knock sensor (KS) system uses one or 2 flat response 2-wire sensors. The sensor uses piezo-electric crystal technology that produces an AC voltage signal of varying amplitude and frequency based on the engine vibration or noise level. The control module receives the KS signal through a signal circuit. The KS ground is supplied by the control module through a low reference circuit. The control module learns a minimum noise level, or background noise, at idle from the KS and uses calibrated values for the rest of the RPM range. The control module uses the minimum noise level to calculate a noise channel. A normal KS signal will ride within the noise channel. As engine speed and load change, the noise channel upper and lower parameters will change to accommodate the normal KS signal, keeping the signal within the channel. In order to determine which cylinders are knocking, the control module only uses KS signal information when each cylinder is near top dead center (TDC) of the firing stroke. If knock is present, the signal will range outside of the noise channel. If the control module has determined that knock is present, it will retard the ignition timing to attempt to eliminate the knock. The control module will always try to work back to a zero compensation level, or no spark retard. An abnormal KS signal will stay outside of the noise channel or will not be present. KS diagnostics are calibrated to detect faults with the KS circuitry inside the control module, the KS wiring, or the KS voltage output. Some diagnostics are also calibrated to detect constant noise from an outside influence such as a loose/damaged component or excessive engine mechanical noise. Page 810 Page 3177 Engine Oil: Service and Repair Engine Oil and Oil Filter Replacement Removal Procedure Important: In order to completely drain the oil from the oil pan internal baffling, the bottom of the oil pan must be level during the oil drain procedure. 1. Open the hood. 2. Remove the oil fill cap. 3. Raise and suitably support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 4. Place a oil drain pan under the oil pan drain plug. 5. Remove the oil pan drain plug. 6. Drain the engine oil. 7. Remove the oil filter from the oil pan. 8. Inspect the old oil filter to ensure that the filter seal is not left on the oil pan. Page 887 View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. View of the release tool being used for the smaller terminals. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (2-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 7372 4. Use a small flat-blade tool to slide the terminal position assurance (TPA) up one notch on both ends of the connector. The TPA is located underneath the wire dress cover. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 4406 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) and slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. Page 8315 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Start in the middle and gradually move the heat barrel to the open ends of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Heated Oxygen Sensor Wiring Repairs HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being obstructed. If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. - Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks, etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire. - Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance. - To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector. Page 2388 breakers are used. CIRCUIT BREAKER This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high current is removed. POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) CIRCUIT BREAKER This type greatly increases its resistance when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker will re-close within a second or 2. Circuit Protection - Fuses CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSES The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and examine the element in the fuse for an open (2). If not broken (1), also check for continuity using a DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one of equal current rating. Circuit Protection - Fusible Links CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSIBLE LINKS Page 5430 11. Insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) into the 2 triangular cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 12. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE 1. Prior to installation the terminal must be aligned so the (1) coding lugs align with the (2) coding grooves on the connector. 2. Once the terminal is aligned, slide the terminal into the cavity until the retainer has engaged in the cavity of the connector. 3. Slide the TPA in the connector body and seat it using a small flat bladed tool. The TPA is seated when it is flush with the contact housing. 4. Secure the wires to the connector body using a tie wrap and replace the dress cover and grommet. Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) BOSCH CONNECTORS (2.8 JPT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Pull out the slider on the connector position assurance (CPA) until it is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 3861 For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 8998 Page 6408 Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids Arrows and Symbols Arrows and Symbols This Service Data uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations. Arrows and Symbols 1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow Basic Knowledge Required GENERAL ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures contained in the service manual. You should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current (amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram, as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. Decimal and Metric Equivalents Decimal and Metric Equivalents Page 1155 For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 6382 11. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 12. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 13. Center the high temperature SCT1 shrink tube over the DuraSeal splice sleeve. 14. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the high temperature heat shrink tubing. 15. Gradually move the heat from the center to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 16. Replace any reflective tape and clips that may have been remove during the repair. Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation REPAIRING DAMAGED WIRE INSULATION Wire Size Conversion Page 191 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (BSK) BOSCH CONNECTORS (BSK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 3. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 4. Insert the J 38125-561 tool into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 5. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is Page 1635 View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. View of the release tool being used for the smaller terminals. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (2-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 8246 Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. For connectors with a bolt in the dress cover, turn the bolt counterclockwise to remove the connector from the component. 2. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. Page 7024 Release the tabs that are holding the wiredress cover to the connector body. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the slots on both ends of the connector body. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. J 38125-216 can also be used to remove the nose piece. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by lifting the terminal retaining tabs on the inside of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 7021 Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. For connectors with a bolt in the dress cover, turn the bolt counterclockwise to remove the connector from the component. 2. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. Page 6544 11. Insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) into the 2 triangular cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 12. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE 1. Prior to installation the terminal must be aligned so the (1) coding lugs align with the (2) coding grooves on the connector. 2. Once the terminal is aligned, slide the terminal into the cavity until the retainer has engaged in the cavity of the connector. 3. Slide the TPA in the connector body and seat it using a small flat bladed tool. The TPA is seated when it is flush with the contact housing. 4. Secure the wires to the connector body using a tie wrap and replace the dress cover and grommet. Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) BOSCH CONNECTORS (2.8 JPT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Pull out the slider on the connector position assurance (CPA) until it is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 7858 Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Heated Oxygen Sensor Replacement - Bank 2 Sensor 1 Heated Oxygen Sensor Replacement - Bank 2 Sensor 1 Removal Procedure Notice: Refer to Heated Oxygen and Oxygen Sensor Notice. Notice: Refer to Excessive Force and Oxygen Sensor Notice. 1. Raise and suitably support the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Unscrew the heated oxygen sensor (HO2S) sensor from the catalytic converter. 3. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) retainer. 4. Disconnect the HO2S electrical connector (2). Installation Procedure Page 7927 15. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground wire terminal. 16. Install the electrical ground wire terminal to the rivet stud. 17. Select a M6 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 18. Install the M6 conductive nut to the rivet stud and: Tighten Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb in). 19. Verify proper system operation. M6 Weld Nut Caution Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground repair. 1. If the M6 weld nut at the electrical ground location is damaged or stripped, a M7 conductive self-threading bolt may be used to secure the ground wire terminal. 2. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the surface surrounding the weld nut and allow to dry. 3. Remove any loose metal particles from the damaged or stripped weld nut with a stiff brush. 4. Select a M7 conductive self-threading bolt. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin 5. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M7 conductive self-threading bolt. Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase. 6. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground wire terminal. 7. Install the electrical ground wire terminal to the M7 conductive self-threading bolt. 8. Install the M7 conductive self-threading bolt and: Tighten Tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb in). 9. Verify proper system operation. M6 Weld Nut Alternative Repair Caution Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground repair. 1. If the electrical ground location is accessible from both sides of the panel, a M6 conductive bolt and a M6 conductive nut may be used to secure the electrical ground wire terminal. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 2. Select a location adjacent the damaged M6 weld nut having 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance behind the panel surface and 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance surrounding the new electrical ground site. 3. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the surface surrounding the ground location and allow to dry. Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled. 4. Drill a 8.5 mm (0.33 in) diameter hole through the panel. 5. Remove paint and primer from the area surrounding the 8.5 mm (0.33 in) hole until bare metal is visible. 6. Select a M6 conductive bolt. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 7. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M6 conductive bolt. Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase. 8. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground wire terminal. 9. Install the electrical ground wire terminal and the M6 conductive bolt to the ground location. 10. Select a M6 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 11. Install the M6 conductive nut to the bolt and: Page 2197 All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system. Page 4926 The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors. 1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position. 4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool J 38125-10A (GM P/N 12014012-1) into the front (mating end) of the connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal through the back of the connector (2). IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector. 6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. 7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily. 10. Perform system check. Delphi Connectors (12 Way) DELPHI CONNECTORS (12-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. Page 510 REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. The release tab is located on the top of the wiredress cover. View of connector in released position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Page 8492 1. Locate the air flow direction arrow (2) on the MAF/IAT sensor. 2. Install the MAF/IAT sensor on to the air cleaner housing. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 3. Tighten the clamp securing the MAF/IAT sensor to the air cleaner housing. Tighten the clamp to 7 N.m (62 lb in). 4. Install the air cleaner outlet duct. 5. Install the air cleaner outlet duct bolt. Tighten the bolt to 10 N.m (89 lb in). 6. Tighten the clamps at the MAF/IAT sensor and the throttle body. Tighten the clamps to 7 N.m (62 lb in). Page 7700 Knock Sensor: Description and Operation Knock Sensor (KS) System Description Purpose The knock sensor (KS) system enables the control module to control the ignition timing for the best possible performance while protecting the engine from potentially damaging levels of detonation. The control module uses the KS system to test for abnormal engine noise that may indicate detonation, also known as spark knock. Sensor Description This knock sensor (KS) system uses one or 2 flat response 2-wire sensors. The sensor uses piezo-electric crystal technology that produces an AC voltage signal of varying amplitude and frequency based on the engine vibration or noise level. The control module receives the KS signal through a signal circuit. The KS ground is supplied by the control module through a low reference circuit. The control module learns a minimum noise level, or background noise, at idle from the KS and uses calibrated values for the rest of the RPM range. The control module uses the minimum noise level to calculate a noise channel. A normal KS signal will ride within the noise channel. As engine speed and load change, the noise channel upper and lower parameters will change to accommodate the normal KS signal, keeping the signal within the channel. In order to determine which cylinders are knocking, the control module only uses KS signal information when each cylinder is near top dead center (TDC) of the firing stroke. If knock is present, the signal will range outside of the noise channel. If the control module has determined that knock is present, it will retard the ignition timing to attempt to eliminate the knock. The control module will always try to work back to a zero compensation level, or no spark retard. An abnormal KS signal will stay outside of the noise channel or will not be present. KS diagnostics are calibrated to detect faults with the KS circuitry inside the control module, the KS wiring, or the KS voltage output. Some diagnostics are also calibrated to detect constant noise from an outside influence such as a loose/damaged component or excessive engine mechanical noise. Page 2495 Release the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the blue locking tabs on both ends of the connector. Gently slide the TPA up to the released position on both ends. 6. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-13A (GM P/N 12031876-1) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. Page 7397 Release the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the blue locking tabs on both ends of the connector. Gently slide the TPA up to the released position on both ends. 6. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-13A (GM P/N 12031876-1) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. Page 493 - Yazaki has a wedge or arrow shape, similar to that shown. Delphi Connectors (Micro .64) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro 64 connectors. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. The lever lock may be located on the top or sides of the wire dress cover. Page 423 3. Ensure that the terminal release tang access panel is in the correct location to access the terminals. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) into the terminal release tang access slot located behind the access panel of the connector and press down on the terminal while carefully pulling the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Tyco/AMP Connectors (0.25 Cap) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (025 CAP) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component by pressing down on the connector position assurance (CPA). Page 2469 REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. The release tab is located on the top of the wiredress cover. View of connector in released position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Page 8631 For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Diagram Information and Instructions Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions Electrical Symbols Page 1799 Knock Sensor: Service and Repair Knock Sensor Replacement (Right Side) Knock Sensor Replacement (Right Side) Removal Procedure 1. Disconnect the electrical connector (3) from the knock sensor (2). 2. Remove the knock sensor bolt (1). 3. Remove the knock sensor (2) from the engine block. Installation Procedure 1. Position the knock sensor (2) on the engine block. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Install the knock sensor bolt (1). Tighten the bolt (1) to 20 N.m (15 lb ft). 3. Connect the electrical connector (3) to the knock sensor (2). Lumbar Horizontal Position Sensor Lumbar Horizontal Position Sensor - Driver (w/Memory) Page 8536 - JST connectors have JST in small letters on their connectors, similar to that above. The location of the logo will vary with the connector size and style. - Kostel has an "LK" with a circle around it. These connector are usually used as a transmissions connection and are currently use on some Cadillac vehicles. Page 5658 Utility/Van Zoning UTILITY/VAN ZONING Page 7975 Page 1442 5. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove TPA from the connector. 6. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Page 8654 Refer to the following table as a guide in selecting the correct test adapter for front probing connectors: Backprobe IMPORTANT: Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures. - Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector. - Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large of a test probe. - After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected, test for proper terminal contact. Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the connector. Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure SCAN TOOL SNAPSHOT PROCEDURE Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used Page 4388 Connector Anatomy Connector Repairs contains a list of all connector repairs. The connector repairs are listed by the connector manufacturer and then by connector type. If the technician cannot identify the manufacturer of the connector, refer to Identifying Connectors below. Knowing the connector manufacturer will assist in finding the correct connector repair from the following list: - Connector Position Assurance Locks - Terminal Position Assurance Locks - Bosch Connectors (0.64) Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) Bosch Connectors (BSK) Bosch Connectors (ECM) - Delphi Connectors (Micro.64) Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) Delphi Connectors (12-Way) - Tyco/AMP Connectors (CM 42-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) Tyco/AMP Connectors (025 Cap) Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) - Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) - Repairing Connector Terminals IDENTIFYING CONNECTORS Knowing the connector manufacturer is helpful when trying to locating the correct connector repair procedure. There are many different connector designs used on GM vehicles and it is sometimes difficult to identify the connector manufacturer. The information in this document should help with the identification of connector manufactures. The following connector manufacturers make most of the connectors found in GM vehicles: AFL/EPC (Alcoa Fujikura Ltd./Engineered Plastics Components) - Bosch - Delphi - FCI (Framatome Connectors International) - JAE (Japan Aviation Electronics) - JST (Japan Solderless Terminals) Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial Force Variation (RFV) Wheels: Customer Interest Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial Force Variation (RFV) INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 00-03-10-006F Date: May 04, 2010 Subject: Information on Tire Radial Force Variation (RFV) Models: 2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X 2000-2005 Saturn L Series 2003-2007 Saturn ION Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to considerably expand the available information on Radial Force Variation (RFV) and should be reviewed in whole. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 00-03-10-006E (Section 03 - Suspension). Important - Before measuring tires on equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700, the vehicle MUST be driven a minimum of 16 km (10 mi) to ensure removal of any flat-spotting. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 03-03-10-007E - Tire/Wheel Characteristics of GM Original Equipment Tires. - Equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700 MUST be calibrated prior to measuring tire/wheel assemblies for each vehicle. The purpose of this bulletin is to provide guidance to GM dealers when using tire force variation measurement equipment, such as the Hunter GSP9700. This type of equipment can be a valuable tool in diagnosing vehicle ride concerns. The most common ride concern involving tire radial force variation is highway speed shake on smooth roads. Tire related smooth road highway speed shake can be caused by three conditions: imbalance, out of round and tire force variation. These three conditions are not necessarily related. All three conditions must be addressed. Imbalance is normally addressed first, because it is the simpler of the three to correct. Off-vehicle, two plane dynamic wheel balancers are readily available and can accurately correct any imbalance. Balancer calibration and maintenance, proper attachment of the wheel to the balancer, and proper balance weights, are all factors required for a quality balance. However, a perfectly balanced tire/wheel assembly can still be "oval shaped" and cause a vibration. Before balancing, perform the following procedures. Tire and Wheel Diagnosis 1. Set the tire pressure to the placard values. 2. With the vehicle raised, ensure the wheels are centered on the hub by loosening all wheel nuts and hand-tightening all nuts first by hand while shaking the wheel, then torque to specifications using a torque wrench, NOT a torque stick. 3. Visually inspect the tires and the wheels. Inspect for evidence of the following conditions and correct as necessary: - Missing balance weights - Bent rim flange - Irregular tire wear - Incomplete bead seating - Tire irregularities (including pressure settings) - Mud/ice build-up in wheel - Stones in the tire tread - Remove any aftermarket wheels and/or tires and restore vehicle to original condition prior to diagnosing a smooth road shake condition. 4. Road test the vehicle using the Electronic Vibration Analyzer (EVA) essential tool. Drive for a sufficient distance on a known, smooth road surface to duplicate the condition. Determine if the vehicle is sensitive to brake apply. If the brakes are applied lightly and the pulsation felt in the steering wheel increases, refer to the Brakes section of the service manual that deals with brake-induced pulsation. If you can start to hear the vibration as a low boom noise (in addition to feeling it), but cannot see it, the vehicle likely has a first order (one pulse per propshaft revolution) driveline vibration. Driveline first order vibrations are high enough in frequency that most humans can start to hear them at highway speeds, but are too high to be able to be easily seen. These issues can be caused by driveline imbalance or misalignment. If the vehicle exhibits this low boom and the booming pulses in-and-out on a regular basis (like a throbbing), chances are good that the vehicle could have driveline vibration. This type Page 4076 Engine Oil: Fluid Type Specifications ENGINE OIL TYPE LOOK FOR TWO THINGS: 1.Your vehicle's engine requires oil meeting GM Standard GM6094M. 2.SAE 5W-30 is best for your vehicle. These numbers on an oil container show its viscosity, or thickness. Do not use other viscosity oils such as SAE 20W-50. Oils meeting these requirements should also have the starburst symbol on the container. This symbol indicates that the oil has been certified by the American Petroleum Institute (API). You should look for this information on the oil container, and use only those oils that are identified as meeting GM Standard GM6094M and have the starburst symbol on the front of the oil container. NOTICE: Use only engine oil identified as meeting GM Standard GM6094M and showing the American Petroleum Institute Certified For Gasoline Engines starburst symbol. Failure to use the recommended oil can result in engine damage not covered by your warranty. GM Goodwrench oil meets all the requirements for your vehicle. If you are in an area of extreme cold, where the temperature falls below -20°F (-29°C), it is recommended that you use either an SAE 5W-30 synthetic oil or an SAE 0W-30 oil. Both will provide easier cold starting and better protection for your engine at extremely low temperatures. ENGINE OIL ADDITIVES Do not add anything to your oil. The recommended oils with the starburst symbol that meet GM Standard GM6094M are all you will need for good performance and engine protection. Page 157 For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to refer to the table above. Disclaimer Page 8031 2. Locate the two indents of the terminal position assurance (TPA) located on the bottom of the connector body. Page 3271 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Ensure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the Terminal Removal Procedure. Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PULL TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL If the terminal is visibly damaged or is suspected of having a faulty connection, the terminal should be replaced. Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors: 1. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) device and/or the secondary lock. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component or separate the connectors for in-line connectors. 3. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device. 4. Insert the proper pick or removal tool into the front of the connector body. 5. IMPORTANT: On connectors with more than one terminal the service loop may not be large enough to remove the terminal and crimp on a new one. If the terminal wire does not have a large enough service loop for removal, cut the wire 5 cm (2 in) behind the connector before removal. Grasp the wire at the back of the connector body and gently push the terminal out the front of the connector body. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. If the wire needed to be cut in order to remove the terminal, gently push a small length of the same size wire through the back of the connector cavity until there is enough wire exposed in order to crimp on a new terminal. If the wire was not cut, cut the existing wire as close to the old terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 4. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. TERMINAL INSTALLATION 1. Align the terminal and pull the wire from the back of the connector in order to seat the terminal. 2. If necessary, cut the new wire to proper length and splice with existing circuit. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. 3. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply dielectric grease to the connector. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PUSH TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 8184 3. Use a small flat-bladed tool to gently pry off the dress cover by inserting the tool under the cover opposite the harness side and prying up. 4. Remove the cover. 5. Using a small flat-bladed tool, push on the side of the nose piece retainer while pushing the nose piece forward with your thumb. This will release the terminal position assurance (TPA). 6. Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) into the corresponding terminal release cavity. The release cavities are the 2 center rows of cavities on one half of the connector. Page 5102 8. Take a CLEAR digital picture of the Tech 2(R) Vehicle Information screen showing the engine Calibration IDs and Verification Numbers as shown above. Retain the printout information and the Tech 2(R) screen photograph with the repair order. Note All pictures must be sent as a.jpg file. 9. E-mail a copy of the picture to [email protected]. In the subject line of the e-mail include the phrase "V8 Cal" as well as the complete VIN and Dealer BAC. In the body of the e-mail, include the VIN, mileage, R.O. number and BAC. Include a brief description of the customer concern and cause of the concern. Note The dealer will receive an e-mail reply after the calibrations have been validated. The e-mail reply will advise the dealer if the calibrations are OEM. 10. Allow two hours for the PQC to verify the calibrations and set up the case details. ‹› If the PQC determines that the calibrations ARE aftermarket calibrations, DO NOT contact GM Technical Assistance to discuss warranty concerns on the aftermarket calibrations. ALL questions and concerns about warranty should be directed to the dealers Fixed Operations Manager (FOM), (Warranty Manager (WM) in Canada). 11. You may call the PQC two hours after submitting the e-mail for authorization to replace the assembly. This will provide them time to receive, review and set up a case on the request. Please be prepared to provide all the usual documentation that is normally required when requesting an assembly authorization from the PQC. Tech 2(R) Displaying All Zeroes for the Verification Numbers on the Calibration ID and Verification Number Screen If the Tech 2(R) that you are using displays all zeroes for the Verification Numbers as shown, then perform the following steps: 1. Update the Tech 2(R) with the latest software from TIS2WEB. 2. Turn OFF the ignition for 90 seconds. 3. Connect the Tech 2(R) to the vehicle. 4. Turn ON the ignition, and build the vehicle. Observe the Tech 2(R) Calibration ID and Verification Number screen for proper operation. ‹› If the Tech 2(R) screen still does not display properly, then turn OFF the ignition for 90 seconds again. Turn ON the ignition and observe the same screen for proper operation. Retrieving Calibrations From a Global A Vehicle This information applies to the 2010 Camaro and is typical of the procedure that will be used on Global A vehicles. 1. Turn OFF the ignition. Page 8113 Page 3243 Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested: - Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. - Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a component or to other harnesses. - If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A TEST LAMP TOOLS REQUIRED J 35616-200 Test Light - Probe Kit NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminate even though voltage is present. The J 35616-200 is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair of leads. To properly operate this tool use the following procedures. When testing for voltage: 1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested. When testing for ground: 1. Attach one lead to battery positive voltage. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where ground should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is ground at the point being tested. Using Connector Test Adapters USING CONNECTOR TEST ADAPTERS NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Using Fused Jumper Wires USING FUSED JUMPER WIRES TOOLS REQUIRED J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged. The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested. AFL/ECP Connectors AFL/EPC CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 4381 difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Bosch Connectors (ECM) BOSCH CONNECTORS (ECM) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the assist lever on the top of the connector. Move the assist lever to the forward position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 5507 7. Connect the MAF/IAT electrical connector. Page 6427 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. 4. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front of the connector. Page 5190 The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors. 1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position. 4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool J 38125-10A (GM P/N 12014012-1) into the front (mating end) of the connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal through the back of the connector (2). IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector. 6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. 7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily. 10. Perform system check. Delphi Connectors (12 Way) DELPHI CONNECTORS (12-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. Page 4849 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert a small flat-blade tool in the slot below the front loaded terminal position assurance (TPA) and pry up. 3. Remove the TPA by pulling it out of the connector. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-553 (GM P/N 15315247) on a slight upward angle into the cavity below the terminal to be removed. Ensure that the pointed on the end of the tool is facing the bottom of the terminal and it stays in contact with the terminal until it stops on the plastic terminal retainer. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 6350 View of typical connector. View of connector in released position. 1. Locate the assist lever at the back of the connector. Move the assist lever to the rear position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the dress cover. Page 4733 Disclaimer Page 1574 Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. For connectors with a bolt in the dress cover, turn the bolt counterclockwise to remove the connector from the component. 2. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. Page 855 The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors. 1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position. 4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool J 38125-10A (GM P/N 12014012-1) into the front (mating end) of the connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal through the back of the connector (2). IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector. 6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. 7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily. 10. Perform system check. Delphi Connectors (12 Way) DELPHI CONNECTORS (12-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. Page 2339 - Yazaki has a wedge or arrow shape, similar to that shown. Delphi Connectors (Micro .64) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro 64 connectors. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. The lever lock may be located on the top or sides of the wire dress cover. Page 8244 - A control module from another vehicle is installed. - Revised software/calibration files have been released for this vehicle. - IMPORTANT: DO NOT re-program the control module with the SAME software/calibration files that are already present in the control module. This is not an effective repair for any type of concern. Verify that the control module contains the correct software/calibration. If incorrect programming is found, reprogram the control module with the most current software/calibration. Refer to Control Module References for replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Testing for Short to Ground TESTING FOR SHORT TO GROUND NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 4. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit. With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is a short to ground in the circuit. Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2. Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). - When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. - If the DMM does not display voltage 4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is shorted. Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A DIGITAL MULTIMETER NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the powertrain control module (PCM), should only be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200 Digital Multimeter (DMM). The J 39200 instruction manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminage even though voltage is present. The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity. IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading. Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the measurement. Page 2316 Refer to the following table as a guide in selecting the correct test adapter for front probing connectors: Backprobe IMPORTANT: Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures. - Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector. - Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large of a test probe. - After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected, test for proper terminal contact. Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the connector. Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure SCAN TOOL SNAPSHOT PROCEDURE Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used Page 3423 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert a small flat-blade tool in the slot below the front loaded terminal position assurance (TPA) and pry up. 3. Remove the TPA by pulling it out of the connector. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-553 (GM P/N 15315247) on a slight upward angle into the cavity below the terminal to be removed. Ensure that the pointed on the end of the tool is facing the bottom of the terminal and it stays in contact with the terminal until it stops on the plastic terminal retainer. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 5180 View of the connector when released from the component. View of another type of Micro 64 connector. Locations Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Locations Engine Controls Component Views Upper Right Side of the Engine - Front 1 - Engine 2 - Engine Harness 3 - Air Duct 4 - Mass Air Flow (MAF)/Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor Page 6679 Connector Anatomy Connector Repairs contains a list of all connector repairs. The connector repairs are listed by the connector manufacturer and then by connector type. If the technician cannot identify the manufacturer of the connector, refer to Identifying Connectors below. Knowing the connector manufacturer will assist in finding the correct connector repair from the following list: - Connector Position Assurance Locks - Terminal Position Assurance Locks - Bosch Connectors (0.64) Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) Bosch Connectors (BSK) Bosch Connectors (ECM) - Delphi Connectors (Micro.64) Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) Delphi Connectors (12-Way) - Tyco/AMP Connectors (CM 42-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) Tyco/AMP Connectors (025 Cap) Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) - Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) - Repairing Connector Terminals IDENTIFYING CONNECTORS Knowing the connector manufacturer is helpful when trying to locating the correct connector repair procedure. There are many different connector designs used on GM vehicles and it is sometimes difficult to identify the connector manufacturer. The information in this document should help with the identification of connector manufactures. The following connector manufacturers make most of the connectors found in GM vehicles: AFL/EPC (Alcoa Fujikura Ltd./Engineered Plastics Components) - Bosch - Delphi - FCI (Framatome Connectors International) - JAE (Japan Aviation Electronics) - JST (Japan Solderless Terminals) Page 5683 11. Insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) into the 2 triangular cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 12. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE 1. Prior to installation the terminal must be aligned so the (1) coding lugs align with the (2) coding grooves on the connector. 2. Once the terminal is aligned, slide the terminal into the cavity until the retainer has engaged in the cavity of the connector. 3. Slide the TPA in the connector body and seat it using a small flat bladed tool. The TPA is seated when it is flush with the contact housing. 4. Secure the wires to the connector body using a tie wrap and replace the dress cover and grommet. Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) BOSCH CONNECTORS (2.8 JPT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Pull out the slider on the connector position assurance (CPA) until it is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 4555 The engine harness may be repaired using the J-38125. High Temperature Wiring Repairs HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperatures, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time may use materials i.e. wires, connectors, and shielding that has a higher heat rating than typical wiring. When making a repair in a high temperature area observe the following: Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature to replace any damaged wire. - Replace any heat shielding that is removed. - Cover any DuraSeal splice sleeves with SCT1 shrink tubing (available in the J-38125 Terminal Repair kit). - After making a wiring repair, ensure that the location of the wiring is not moved closer to the heat source. IDENTIFYING HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperature, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time need special considerations when making wiring repairs. Areas that may be exposed to higher temperatures can be identified by heat resistant materials that are being used in those areas. These materials may include heat reflective tape, moon tape, and high temperature shrink tubing. Also conduit and other protective coverings may be used. Because conduit or similar coverings are used throughout the vehicle regardless of the temperature, it may be necessary for the technician to determine if an area is exposed to excessive heat before making a wiring repair. Obvious areas of consideration would be any area located near the exhaust manifolds, catalytic converter, and exhaust pipes. The J-38125 contains much of the material you will need to perform repairs on areas exposed to high heat. The kit contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves to crimp and seal connections - High temperature SCT1 shrink tubing to protect the splice sleeves - A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct crimp tool to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools to remove the terminals from the connectors The J-38125 does not contain wire that is suitable to high temperature exposure. Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature of the same or larger gage size as the original wire when repair damage wire. Also replace any reflective tape that you remove during the repair. HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature rating of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125 and then encapsulate the splice sleeve using the high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the order listed. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip keeping all of the wire strands intact. Page 7189 The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors. 1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position. 4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool J 38125-10A (GM P/N 12014012-1) into the front (mating end) of the connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal through the back of the connector (2). IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector. 6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. 7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily. 10. Perform system check. Delphi Connectors (12 Way) DELPHI CONNECTORS (12-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. Page 5423 Release the tabs that are holding the wiredress cover to the connector body. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the slots on both ends of the connector body. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. J 38125-216 can also be used to remove the nose piece. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by lifting the terminal retaining tabs on the inside of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 4219 Oil Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Engine Oil Pressure Sensor and/or Switch Replacement Tools Required J 41712 Oil Pressure Switch Socket Removal Procedure 1. Remove the intake manifold. Refer to Intake Manifold Replacement. 2. Disconnect the oil pressure sensor electrical connector (1). 3. Using J 41712 or equivalent, remove the oil pressure sensor. Installation Procedure Page 4360 Page 666 Engine Control Module: Locations Engine Controls Component Views Engine Control Module (ECM) 1 - Engine Control Module (ECM) 2 - Engine Control Module (ECM) C3 3 - Engine Control Module (ECM) C2 4 - Engine Control Module (ECM) C1 Page 1315 Refer to the following table as a guide in selecting the correct test adapter for front probing connectors: Backprobe IMPORTANT: Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures. - Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector. - Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large of a test probe. - After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected, test for proper terminal contact. Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the connector. Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure SCAN TOOL SNAPSHOT PROCEDURE Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used Page 749 5. While pushing the terminal forward, insert the J 38125-24 in the release cavity above the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (43-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Page 5796 Knock Sensor: Diagnostic Aids Arrows and Symbols Arrows and Symbols This Service Data uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations. Arrows and Symbols 1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow Basic Knowledge Required GENERAL ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures contained in the service manual. You should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current (amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram, as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. Decimal and Metric Equivalents Decimal and Metric Equivalents Page 2471 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. JST Connectors JST CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, remove the connector from the component. Page 3448 Fuse Block - Rear C1 (Pin A11 To E7) Page 6556 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert terminal into the appropriate terminal holder until it hits bottom and stops. The correct terminal holder is determined by the wire size. Also ensure that the terminals wings are pointing towards the former on the tool and the release locator. 5. Insert the stripped cable into the terminal. Insulation should be visible on both sides of the terminal insulation wings. 6. Compress the handles until the ratchet automatically releases. 7. Place the terminal into the appropriate cavity and assemble the connector. Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO-PACK 100W) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W connectors. These connectors are very similar but use different terminals and have some minor physical differences also. Page 3477 11. Disconnect the mobile telephone harness connector (1) from the junction block. 12. Disconnect the body wiring harness connector (1) from the junction block. 13. Disconnect the headliner harness connector (2) from the junction block. 14. Disconnect the console harness connector from the junction block. 15. Remove the block base retaining nuts from the floor studs. 16. Remove the block base from the floor panel. INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 1. Install the block base to the floor studs. 2. NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice. Install the block base retaining nuts to the floor studs. Tighten the block base retaining nuts to 10 N.m (88 lb in). 3. Connect the console harness connector to the block base. 4. Connect the headliner harness connector (2) to the block base. 5. Connect the body wiring harness connector (1) to the block base. 6. Connect the mobile telephone harness connector (1) to the junction block. Page 1849 Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. For connectors with a bolt in the dress cover, turn the bolt counterclockwise to remove the connector from the component. 2. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. Page 300 Memory Seat Module - Driver C2 (w/Memory) Page 7004 Page 5183 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert terminal into the appropriate terminal holder until it hits bottom and stops. The correct terminal holder is determined by the wire size. Also ensure that the terminals wings are pointing towards the former on the tool and the release locator. 5. Insert the stripped cable into the terminal. Insulation should be visible on both sides of the terminal insulation wings. 6. Compress the handles until the ratchet automatically releases. 7. Place the terminal into the appropriate cavity and assemble the connector. Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO-PACK 100W) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W connectors. These connectors are very similar but use different terminals and have some minor physical differences also. Page 5940 MEASURING FREQUENCY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal. IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM to autorange to an appropriate range. 1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency measured. Measuring Voltage MEASURING VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit. 1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods: - Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. - Turn ON the engine. - Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls. - Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested. 3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The DMM displays the voltage measured at that point. Measuring Voltage Drop MEASURING VOLTAGE DROP NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points. Probing Electrical Connectors PROBING ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS Page 6449 TERMINAL REMOVAL Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors. 1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA) device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1). 3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 4. Gently pull the cable and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector. 5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal, refer to Terminal Repair. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3. Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector. REINSTALLING TERMINAL 1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly, refer to Wiring Repairs. 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3. Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) DELPHI CONNECTORS (WEATHER PACK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 6444 The first connector design of the Micro-Pack 100W (1) has a white connector interface that holds the terminals. The second design of the Micro-Pack 100W (2) has a gray interface to hold the terminals. Also, the first design has terminal cavities that are further apart (3 mm centerline) and offset from the other row of terminal cavities in the connector. The second design has terminals cavities that are closer together (2.54 mm centerline) and aligned vertically. One other way to identify the second design is the thin strip of material that runs along the outside of the cavities. IMPORTANT: There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W terminals which are very similar. Ensure that you have the correct terminal before crimping the new terminal to the wire. The first design connector uses the longer terminal (1) that has a raised area in front of the recess in the terminal. The second design connector uses the shorter terminal without the raised area. Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro-Pack 100W connectors. Some Micro-Pack 100W connector disassembly procedures will vary. Use this procedure as a guide. 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 8708 3. Remove the dress cover by using a flat-blade tool to release the connector locking tabs and pulling off the dress cover. 4. Relieve the tension on the nose piece retainers by inserting J-38125-12A (12094429) into the single retainer slot on the end of the nose piece and gently prying out the locking tab. Repeat the process for both of the nose piece locking tabs on the opposite side of the nose piece. Page 5863 2. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 2027 3. Use a small flat-bladed tool to gently pry off the dress cover by inserting the tool under the cover opposite the harness side and prying up. 4. Remove the cover. 5. Using a small flat-bladed tool, push on the side of the nose piece retainer while pushing the nose piece forward with your thumb. This will release the terminal position assurance (TPA). 6. Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) into the corresponding terminal release cavity. The release cavities are the 2 center rows of cavities on one half of the connector. Page 8926 7. Apply pressure and gently rock the cover until one locking leg is unseated. 8. Continue to apply pressure and rock the cover until the second locking leg is unseated. Repeat procedure for the other side of the dress cover and remove the cover. 9. Use J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) to gently lift the terminal retaining tab while gently pulling the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 10. If the terminal is severely bent or damaged, it may be possible on some connectors to push the wire out of the front of the connector instead of Page 7051 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) and slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. Page 858 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the TPA. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the nose piece. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. Page 7360 The first connector design of the Micro-Pack 100W (1) has a white connector interface that holds the terminals. The second design of the Micro-Pack 100W (2) has a gray interface to hold the terminals. Also, the first design has terminal cavities that are further apart (3 mm centerline) and offset from the other row of terminal cavities in the connector. The second design has terminals cavities that are closer together (2.54 mm centerline) and aligned vertically. One other way to identify the second design is the thin strip of material that runs along the outside of the cavities. IMPORTANT: There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W terminals which are very similar. Ensure that you have the correct terminal before crimping the new terminal to the wire. The first design connector uses the longer terminal (1) that has a raised area in front of the recess in the terminal. The second design connector uses the shorter terminal without the raised area. Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro-Pack 100W connectors. Some Micro-Pack 100W connector disassembly procedures will vary. Use this procedure as a guide. 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 3554 13. Use the tire changer in order to install the tire to the wheel. Caution: To avoid serious personal injury, do not stand over tire when inflating. The bead may break when the bead snaps over the safety hump. Do not exceed 275 kPa (40 psi) pressure when inflating any tire if beads are not seated. If 275 kPa (40 psi) pressure will not seat the beads, deflate, lubricate the beads and reinflate. Overinflating may cause the bead to break and cause serious personal injury. Important: Allowable bead seating pressure is 345 kPa (50 psi) on Extended Mobility Tires. 14. Inflate the tire until it passes the bead humps. Be sure that the valve core is not installed at this time. 15. Install the valve core to the valve core stem. 16. Inflate the tire to the proper air pressure. 17. Ensure that the locating rings are visible on both sides of the tire in order to verify that the tire bead is fully seated on the wheel. Parts Information The product shown above is available from GM SPO. Disclaimer Page 1518 Page 6701 REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. The release tab is located on the top of the wiredress cover. View of connector in released position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Page 7215 4. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the rear of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. 5. Once the locking tabs are unlocked, slide the inner connector out of the rear of the connector housing. Page 366 Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. For connectors with a bolt in the dress cover, turn the bolt counterclockwise to remove the connector from the component. 2. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. Page 8455 The engine harness may be repaired using the J-38125. High Temperature Wiring Repairs HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperatures, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time may use materials i.e. wires, connectors, and shielding that has a higher heat rating than typical wiring. When making a repair in a high temperature area observe the following: Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature to replace any damaged wire. - Replace any heat shielding that is removed. - Cover any DuraSeal splice sleeves with SCT1 shrink tubing (available in the J-38125 Terminal Repair kit). - After making a wiring repair, ensure that the location of the wiring is not moved closer to the heat source. IDENTIFYING HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperature, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time need special considerations when making wiring repairs. Areas that may be exposed to higher temperatures can be identified by heat resistant materials that are being used in those areas. These materials may include heat reflective tape, moon tape, and high temperature shrink tubing. Also conduit and other protective coverings may be used. Because conduit or similar coverings are used throughout the vehicle regardless of the temperature, it may be necessary for the technician to determine if an area is exposed to excessive heat before making a wiring repair. Obvious areas of consideration would be any area located near the exhaust manifolds, catalytic converter, and exhaust pipes. The J-38125 contains much of the material you will need to perform repairs on areas exposed to high heat. The kit contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves to crimp and seal connections - High temperature SCT1 shrink tubing to protect the splice sleeves - A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct crimp tool to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools to remove the terminals from the connectors The J-38125 does not contain wire that is suitable to high temperature exposure. Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature of the same or larger gage size as the original wire when repair damage wire. Also replace any reflective tape that you remove during the repair. HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature rating of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125 and then encapsulate the splice sleeve using the high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the order listed. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip keeping all of the wire strands intact. Page 8715 4. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the rear of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. 5. Once the locking tabs are unlocked, slide the inner connector out of the rear of the connector housing. Locations Crankshaft Position Sensor: Locations Engine Controls Component Views Lower Right Side of the Engine - Rear 1 - Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor 2 - Knock Sensor (KS) 2 - Right 3 - Engine Harness 4 Starter 5 - Engine Page 6681 - In some cases Delphi will actually be printed on the connector. If Delphi is not printed on the connector, look for PED. In both cases there is no specific orientation for Delphi or PED and they can appear anywhere on the connector. - FCI connectors may have the FCI logo on their connectors. The logo is the letters FCI with an "A" above it. - JAE connector have JAE in small letters on their connectors. Page 2415 Page 3970 7. If necessary, remove the ignition coil bracket studs from the rocker arm cover. 8. If necessary, remove the ignition coils and bracket from the rocker cover. 9. Remove the vent hose (2) from the valve rocker arm cover (1). Page 8454 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Start in the middle and gradually move the heat barrel to the open ends of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Heated Oxygen Sensor Wiring Repairs HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being obstructed. If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. - Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks, etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire. - Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance. - To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector. Page 6948 2. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully push the terminal position assurance (TPA) towards the face of the connector on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA is fragile and may break if not done carefully. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. 3. Use the J 38125-215 tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 3112 Fluid - A/T: Service and Repair Automatic Transmission Fluid and Filter Replacement Removal Procedure Caution: When the transmission is at operating temperatures, take necessary precautions when removing the drain plug, to avoid being burned by draining fluid. 1. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 2. Remove the catalytic converter. Refer to Catalytic Converter Replacement (4.2L Engine) Catalytic Converter Replacement (5.3L and 6.0L Engines). 3. Place a drain pan under the transmission oil pan. 4. Remove the oil pan drain plug, if equipped. 5. If necessary, remove the bolts and position aside the range selector cable bracket for clearance while lowering the pan. It is not necessary to remove the cable from the lever or bracket. 6. Remove the oil pan bolts from the front and sides of the pan only. 7. Loosen the rear oil pan bolts approximately 4 turns. 8. Lightly tap the oil pan with a rubber mallet in order to loosen the pan to allow the fluid to drain. 9. Remove the remaining oil pan bolts. 10. Remove the oil pan and the gasket. Page 7734 1. Apply sealant to the threads of the oil pressure sensor. Refer to Sealers, Adhesives, and Lubricants for the correct part number. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Using J 41712 or equivalent, install the oil pressure sensor. Tighten the sensor to 35 N.m (26 lb ft). 3. Connect the oil pressure sensor electrical connector (1). 4. Install the intake manifold. Refer to Intake Manifold Replacement. Page 7861 1. If reinstalling the old sensor, coat the threads with anti-seize compound GM P/N 12377953, or equivalent. Notice: Refer to Component Fastener Tightening Notice. 2. Install the HO2S (2). Tighten the sensor to 42 N.m (31 lb ft). 3. Connect the HO2S electrical connector (1). 4. Install the CPA retainer. 5. Lower the vehicle. Page 8463 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches, and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original. - The wires insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the possibility of fuel contact. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1). 5. Select the proper duraseal splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool. Refer to the Crimp and Seal Splice Table. 6. Place the duraseal splice sleeve in the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115) crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 7. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to hold the duraseal splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 8. Insert the wires into the duraseal splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel in order to prevent the wire from passing through the splice (3). 9. Close the handles of the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115), until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is applied to the splice sleeve. 10. Shrink the insulation around the splice. - Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. - Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Splicing Inline Harness Diodes SPLICING INLINE HARNESS DIODES Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure. 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode. 2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool. 5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode. Page 4172 Intake Manifold: Service and Repair Intake Manifold Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. Refer to Battery Negative Cable Disconnection and Connection. Important: The intake manifold, throttle body, fuel rail, and injectors may be removed as an assembly. If not servicing the individual components, remove the manifold as a complete assembly. 2. Remove the air cleaner outlet duct. Refer to Air Cleaner Resonator Outlet Duct Replacement. 3. Relieve the fuel system pressure. Refer to Fuel Pressure Relief. 4. Disconnect the air conditioning (A/C) compressor pressure switch electrical connector (2). 5. Remove the harness clip (1) from the cylinder head. Page 5166 difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Bosch Connectors (ECM) BOSCH CONNECTORS (ECM) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the assist lever on the top of the connector. Move the assist lever to the forward position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 3866 Important: Remove only the outer gasket from the manifold. Do not disassemble any of the internal components of the manifold in an attempt to remove the 8 inner sealing gaskets. If the inner gaskets are cut or damaged, replace the manifold as an assembly. Only use a wire-cutter type tool in order to minimize the amount of debris. Do not use a rotary-type cutting tool on the retaining straps. 6. Identify the 8 gasket retaining strap locations (1-8). 7. Using a wire-cutter type tool, cut the 8 retaining straps of the outer gasket. 8. Remove the outer gasket (1) from the manifold. Page 3257 - Kostel - Molex - Sumitomo - Tyco/AMP - Yazaki Identifying the manufacturer of a connector is often difficult. When trying to determine the manufacturer of a connector, look for specific identifying marks that are unique to that connector supplier. Most of these identify marks are hard to find or see. Check the connector carefully and refer to the information below for pictures and descriptions of connector identification markings. - Most of AFLs connectors have EPC on their connector body. Some of the smaller connectors will not have any markings on them. - In some cases Bosch will actually be printed on the connector. If Bosch does not appear on the connector, look for the Bosch logo. The Bosch logo is a circle with a blunted arrow inside. This logo can appear anywhere on the connector and is often very small. Page 8802 - Most Molex connectors will have the Molex logo on the dresscover of the connector. In some cases the connectors may have MX followed by another letter. The third letter indicates where the connector was made. A connector with MXD is a Molex connector made in Detroit. Sumitomo has a unique symbol on their connector and possibly a part number. The symbol is similar to that of a diamond lying on its side, similar to that shown. The logo could appear anywhere but the most common place is at the wire side of the housing. Tyco/AMP has many different and unique connector designs. Some may or may not have identifiable marks on them. Page 1491 6. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by pressing on the tang. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (SENSOR) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) tool into the cavity on the lower right hand face of the connector until the terminal release tang access panel slides over. Page 4440 2. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully push the terminal position assurance (TPA) towards the face of the connector on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA is fragile and may break if not done carefully. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. 3. Use the J 38125-215 tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 8072 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches, and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original. - The wires insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the possibility of fuel contact. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1). 5. Select the proper duraseal splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool. Refer to the Crimp and Seal Splice Table. 6. Place the duraseal splice sleeve in the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115) crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 7. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to hold the duraseal splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 8. Insert the wires into the duraseal splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel in order to prevent the wire from passing through the splice (3). 9. Close the handles of the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115), until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is applied to the splice sleeve. 10. Shrink the insulation around the splice. - Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. - Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Splicing Inline Harness Diodes SPLICING INLINE HARNESS DIODES Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure. 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode. 2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool. 5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode. Page 156 Important The following information MUST be documented on the repair order. Failure to do so may result in a chargeback. - Customer vehicle condition. - Was a Service Lamp or Service Message illuminated? If yes, specify which Service Lamp or Service Message. - Was a DTC(s) set? If yes, specify which DTC(s) were set. - After following the procedure contained within this bulletin, could the condition be duplicated? ‹› If the condition was not duplicated, then document the affected module/component connector name and number on the repair order. - If the condition was duplicated after the procedure contained within this bulletin was followed, and additional diagnosis led to the replacement of a module or component, the SI Document ID Number MUST be written on the repair order. Parts Information Alternate Distributor For All of North America Note NyoGel(R) 760G Lubricant* is equivalent to GMSPO P/N 12377900, and P/N 10953529 (Canada), specified for use to correct the condition in this bulletin. *We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may be available from other sources. Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to: Warranty Information (Saab Models) Page 4232 Timing Chain: Service and Repair Timing Chain and Sprockets Replacement Tools Required ^ J 8433-1 Puller Bar ^ J 41478 Crankshaft Front Oil Seal Installer ^ J 41558 Crankshaft Sprocket Remover ^ J 41665 Crankshaft Balancer and Sprocket Installer ^ J 41816-2 Crankshaft End Protector Removal Procedure 1. Remove the oil pump. Refer to Oil Pump, Screen, and Crankshaft Oil Deflector Replacement. Notice: Do not turn the crankshaft assembly after the timing chain has been removed in order to prevent damage to the piston assemblies or the valves. 2. Rotate the crankshaft until the timing marks on the crankshaft and the camshaft sprockets are aligned. Notice: Do not turn the crankshaft assembly after the timing chain has been removed in order to prevent damage to the piston assemblies or the valves. 3. Remove and discard the camshaft sprocket bolt (206). 4. Remove the camshaft sprocket (205) and timing chain (208). Page 7846 Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Bank 2 Sensor 1 Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Bank 2 Sensor 2 Page 1172 Air Temperature Sensor - Upper Right Engine Controls - MIL ON/Misfire/Misfire DTC's Set Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL ON/Misfire/Misfire DTC's Set Bulletin No.: 06-06-04-046 Date: September 12, 2006 INFORMATION Subject: Information on Engine Misfire MIL/SES Light Illuminated or Flashing DTC P0300, P0301, P0302, P0303, P0304, P0305, P0306, P0307, P0308, P0420 or P0430 Models: 1999-2007 Cadillac, Chevrolet, GMC Full-Size Pickup and/or Utility Trucks with 4.8L, 5.3L, 5.7L, 6.0L or 6.2L VORTEC GEN III, GEN IV, V-8 Engine (VINs V, C, T, Z, B, 3, M, 0, J, R, U, N, Y, K, 8 - RPOs LR4, LY2, LM7, L59, L33, LC9, LH6, LMG, LY5, L31, LQ4, LQ9, L76, LY6, L92) with Active Fuel Management(TM) and E85 Flex Fuel If you encounter vehicles that exhibit the above conditions, refer to SI for the appropriate DTC(s) set. If no trouble is found, the cause may be due to an ECM ground terminal that has corroded with rust over time. Inspect the main engine wiring harness ground terminal (G103) for this condition. The wire terminal (G103) attaches either to the front or to the rear of the right side cylinder head, depending on the model year of the Full Size Pickup and/or Utility Trucks. If the ECM ground terminal has been found to be corroded, then follow the service procedure outlined in this bulletin to correct the corrosion issue. Remove either the nut or bolt securing the main engine wiring harness ground terminal (G103) to the right cylinder head. Refer to the above illustration to determine where the ground is located on the vehicle (1). Page 1924 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the DuraSeal splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of a connector. CPAs are used in all SIR System connectors and also in some connectors of other systems. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals of a connection. TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE CLIPS IMPORTANT: When making a splice in an area that may be exposed to moisture use a crimp and seal splice sleeve instead of a Splice Clip. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. Page 2448 - Kostel - Molex - Sumitomo - Tyco/AMP - Yazaki Identifying the manufacturer of a connector is often difficult. When trying to determine the manufacturer of a connector, look for specific identifying marks that are unique to that connector supplier. Most of these identify marks are hard to find or see. Check the connector carefully and refer to the information below for pictures and descriptions of connector identification markings. - Most of AFLs connectors have EPC on their connector body. Some of the smaller connectors will not have any markings on them. - In some cases Bosch will actually be printed on the connector. If Bosch does not appear on the connector, look for the Bosch logo. The Bosch logo is a circle with a blunted arrow inside. This logo can appear anywhere on the connector and is often very small. Page 486 11. Insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) into the 2 triangular cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 12. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE 1. Prior to installation the terminal must be aligned so the (1) coding lugs align with the (2) coding grooves on the connector. 2. Once the terminal is aligned, slide the terminal into the cavity until the retainer has engaged in the cavity of the connector. 3. Slide the TPA in the connector body and seat it using a small flat bladed tool. The TPA is seated when it is flush with the contact housing. 4. Secure the wires to the connector body using a tie wrap and replace the dress cover and grommet. Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) BOSCH CONNECTORS (2.8 JPT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Pull out the slider on the connector position assurance (CPA) until it is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 4298 Ignition Cable: Service and Repair Spark Plug Wire Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Remove the spark plug wire from the spark plug. * Twist each spark plug 1/2 turn. * Pull only on the boot in order to remove the wire from each spark plug. 2. Remove the spark plug wire from the ignition coil. * Twist each spark plug boot 1/2 turn. * Pull only on the boot in order to remove the wires from the ignition coil. Installation Procedure 1. Install the spark plug wire to the ignition coil. 2. Install the spark plug wire to the spark plug. 3. Inspect the wires for proper installation: * Push sideways on each boot in order to inspect the seating. * Reinstall any loose boot. Page 6483 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert a small flat-blade tool in the slot below the front loaded terminal position assurance (TPA) and pry up. 3. Remove the TPA by pulling it out of the connector. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-553 (GM P/N 15315247) on a slight upward angle into the cavity below the terminal to be removed. Ensure that the pointed on the end of the tool is facing the bottom of the terminal and it stays in contact with the terminal until it stops on the plastic terminal retainer. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 4635 View of typical connector. View of connector in released position. 1. Locate the assist lever at the back of the connector. Move the assist lever to the rear position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the dress cover. Page 4504 View of the connector when released from the component. View of another type of Micro 64 connector. Page 5080 8. Disconnect the 32-way tan electrical connector (2) from the BCM. 9. Disconnect the 24-way gray electrical connector (1) from the BCM. 10. With an upward motion, remove the BCM (1) from the rear electrical center. INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 1. Index the slots on the BCM (1) to the rear electrical center. 2. Using a downward motion, install the BCM to the rear electrical center. 3. Connect the 24-way gray electrical connector (1) to the BCM. 4. Connect the 32-way tan electrical connector (2) to the BCM. 5. Connect the 40-way body wiring extension (1) to the BCM. Page 7167 5. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove TPA from the connector. 6. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Page 6024 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link). - The wire insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. 5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold them between thumb and forefinger. 7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place. - Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction. - Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip. 8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool closes.Ensure that no strands of wire are cut. 10. Crimp the splice on each end (2). Page 3356 to analyze the data during the time a vehicle condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a trigger point that you have determined. Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2 snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a first-in, first-out basis. If a third snapshot is taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost. Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types: Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice - Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200 frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not lost if the Scan Tool is powered down. The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis. The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected values by plotting 3 parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful, especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC. Testing for a Short to Voltage TESTING FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4. Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt, there is a short to voltage in the circuit. Testing for Continuity TESTING FOR CONTINUITY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6. Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit. 7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity. With a Test Lamp IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits. 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6. If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity. Testing for Electrical Intermittents TESTING FOR ELECTRICAL INTERMITTENTS Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment. - Testing for Short to Ground - Testing for Continuity - Testing for a Short to Voltage Diagram Information and Instructions Fuse: Diagram Information and Instructions Electrical Symbols Page 2871 Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection Fuel System Diagnosis Fuel System Diagnosis Diagnostic Fault Information Perform the Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle prior to using this diagnostic procedure. Circuit/System Description When the ignition is turned ON, the engine control module (ECM) supplies power to the in-tank fuel pump, by energizing the fuel pump relay. The in-tank fuel pump remains ON as long as the engine is cranking or running and the ECM receives crankshaft reference pulses. If there are no reference pulses, the ECM turns the in-tank fuel pump OFF, 2 seconds after the ignition switch is turned ON or 2 seconds after the engine stops running. The electric fuel pump is incorporated into the modular fuel pump and sender assembly and is located inside the fuel tank. The fuel pump supplies fuel through a fuel filter, also located in the modular fuel pump and sender assembly, through the fuel feed pipes, to the fuel rail assembly. The fuel pump provides fuel at a pressure above the pressure needed by the fuel injectors. The fuel pressure regulator, located in the modular fuel pump and sender assembly, keeps the fuel available to the fuel injectors at a regulated pressure. When the fuel pressure rises above the pressure regulator calibration, the pressure is relieved, with excess fuel exhausted into the modular fuel pump and sender assembly reservoir. Circuit/System Verification Important: * Inspect the fuel system for damage or external leaks before proceeding. * Verify that adequate fuel is in the fuel tank before proceeding. * The fuel pump relay may need to be commanded ON a few times in order to obtain the highest possible fuel pressure. Ignition ON, command the fuel pump relay ON with a scan tool. You should hear the fuel pump turn ON and OFF. ‹› If the fuel pump does not operate, refer to Fuel Pump Electrical Circuit Diagnosis. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics * Ignition OFF, all accessories OFF, install the J34730-1A. Refer to Fuel Pressure Gage Installation and Removal. * Ignition ON, command the fuel pump relay ON with a scan tool. Verify the fuel pressure is between 345-414 kPa (50-60 psi) and remains steady for 5 minutes. Circuit/System Testing Important: * The fuel pump relay may need to be commanded ON a few times in order to obtain the highest possible fuel pressure. * DO NOT start the engine. Ignition ON, command the fuel pump relay ON with a scan tool and observe the fuel pressure gage while the fuel pump is operating. Verify the fuel pressure is between 345-414 kPa (50-60 psi). ‹› If the fuel pressure is greater than the specified range, replace the fuel pump. ‹› If the fuel pressure is less than the specified range, remove the fuel tank and test, inspect, and repair the items listed below. If all items test normal, replace the fuel pump. * Restricted fuel feed pipe * Restricted or plugged fuel filter * Restricted or plugged strainer * Stuck or binding fuel level float * Inspect the harness connectors and the ground circuits of the fuel pump for poor connections. Important: The fuel pressure may vary slightly when the fuel pump stops operating. After the fuel pump stops operating, the fuel pressure should stabilize and remain constant. * Verify that the fuel pressure does not decrease more than 34 kPa (5 psi) in 1 minute. ‹› If the fuel pressure decreases more than the specified value, perform the following procedure: Page 4416 View of typical connector. View of connector in released position. 1. Locate the assist lever at the back of the connector. Move the assist lever to the rear position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the dress cover. Page 3718 MEASURING FREQUENCY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal. IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM to autorange to an appropriate range. 1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency measured. Measuring Voltage MEASURING VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit. 1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods: - Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. - Turn ON the engine. - Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls. - Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested. 3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The DMM displays the voltage measured at that point. Measuring Voltage Drop MEASURING VOLTAGE DROP NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points. Probing Electrical Connectors PROBING ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS Page 4909 Connector Anatomy Connector Repairs contains a list of all connector repairs. The connector repairs are listed by the connector manufacturer and then by connector type. If the technician cannot identify the manufacturer of the connector, refer to Identifying Connectors below. Knowing the connector manufacturer will assist in finding the correct connector repair from the following list: - Connector Position Assurance Locks - Terminal Position Assurance Locks - Bosch Connectors (0.64) Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) Bosch Connectors (BSK) Bosch Connectors (ECM) - Delphi Connectors (Micro.64) Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) Delphi Connectors (12-Way) - Tyco/AMP Connectors (CM 42-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) Tyco/AMP Connectors (025 Cap) Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) - Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) - Repairing Connector Terminals IDENTIFYING CONNECTORS Knowing the connector manufacturer is helpful when trying to locating the correct connector repair procedure. There are many different connector designs used on GM vehicles and it is sometimes difficult to identify the connector manufacturer. The information in this document should help with the identification of connector manufactures. The following connector manufacturers make most of the connectors found in GM vehicles: AFL/EPC (Alcoa Fujikura Ltd./Engineered Plastics Components) - Bosch - Delphi - FCI (Framatome Connectors International) - JAE (Japan Aviation Electronics) - JST (Japan Solderless Terminals) Page 4634 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Kostal Connectors KOSTAL CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 5161 Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. For connectors with a bolt in the dress cover, turn the bolt counterclockwise to remove the connector from the component. 2. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. Page 7552 The engine harness may be repaired using the J-38125. High Temperature Wiring Repairs HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperatures, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time may use materials i.e. wires, connectors, and shielding that has a higher heat rating than typical wiring. When making a repair in a high temperature area observe the following: Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature to replace any damaged wire. - Replace any heat shielding that is removed. - Cover any DuraSeal splice sleeves with SCT1 shrink tubing (available in the J-38125 Terminal Repair kit). - After making a wiring repair, ensure that the location of the wiring is not moved closer to the heat source. IDENTIFYING HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperature, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time need special considerations when making wiring repairs. Areas that may be exposed to higher temperatures can be identified by heat resistant materials that are being used in those areas. These materials may include heat reflective tape, moon tape, and high temperature shrink tubing. Also conduit and other protective coverings may be used. Because conduit or similar coverings are used throughout the vehicle regardless of the temperature, it may be necessary for the technician to determine if an area is exposed to excessive heat before making a wiring repair. Obvious areas of consideration would be any area located near the exhaust manifolds, catalytic converter, and exhaust pipes. The J-38125 contains much of the material you will need to perform repairs on areas exposed to high heat. The kit contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves to crimp and seal connections - High temperature SCT1 shrink tubing to protect the splice sleeves - A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct crimp tool to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools to remove the terminals from the connectors The J-38125 does not contain wire that is suitable to high temperature exposure. Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature of the same or larger gage size as the original wire when repair damage wire. Also replace any reflective tape that you remove during the repair. HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature rating of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125 and then encapsulate the splice sleeve using the high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the order listed. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip keeping all of the wire strands intact. Page 5584 7. The illustration above identifies the entry canal where the terminal release tool will be inserted, and the terminal cavity. - Terminal (1) - Entry Canal (2) 8. Insert the J-38125-553 (15315247) tool into the entry canal and pry up on the terminal retainer. The terminal retainer is a small plastic piece on the top of the terminal. The terminal retainer must be held up while the terminal is pulled out of the connector. Page 1954 Page 716 pulling it through. This will prevent damage to the internal seals of the connector. Once the terminal is pushed out of the connector, cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible and pull the wire through the connector. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE The Micro-Pack 100W connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool was developed to crimp Micro-Pack 100W terminals. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 2. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert the terminal into the crimp tool until the core wings are flush with the anvil on the crimp tool. Be sure that the wings are pointed toward the crimp tool former and release the spring locator. The locator will hold the terminal in place. Inspect the alignment of the terminal wings with the crimp tool former. If the terminal wings are wider than the crimp tool former, remove the terminal and bend the terminal wings in slightly. 5. Place stripped wire into terminal. 6. Crimp the new terminal to the wire. If a jam occurs, press the emergency release to open applicator. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire perform the following procedure in order to replace Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. Page 2759 3. Insert the sensor in the wheel hole with the air passage facing away from the wheel. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 4. Install the sensor nut and position the sensor body parallel to the inside wheel surface while torquing. Tighten the sensor nut to 7 N.m (62 lb in). Important: Before installing the tire on the wheel, note the following items to avoid tire pressure sensor damage upon tire mounting: ^ Position the mounting/dismounting head 180 degrees from the valve stem. ^ Position the bead transition area 45 degrees counterclockwise of the valve stem. ^ Using the tire machine, rotate the tire/wheel assembly clockwise when transferring the tire bead to the inside of the wheel rim. ^ Repeat items for outer bead. Install the tire on the wheel. Refer to Tire Mounting and Dismounting . ^ Install the tire/wheel assembly on the vehicle. Refer to Tire and Wheel Removal and Installation. ^ Lower the vehicle. Page 1390 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Start in the middle and gradually move the heat barrel to the open ends of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Heated Oxygen Sensor Wiring Repairs HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being obstructed. If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. - Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks, etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire. - Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance. - To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector. Page 2374 3. Use a small flat-bladed tool to gently pry off the dress cover by inserting the tool under the cover opposite the harness side and prying up. 4. Remove the cover. 5. Using a small flat-bladed tool, push on the side of the nose piece retainer while pushing the nose piece forward with your thumb. This will release the terminal position assurance (TPA). 6. Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) into the corresponding terminal release cavity. The release cavities are the 2 center rows of cavities on one half of the connector. Page 6234 2. Locate the two indents of the terminal position assurance (TPA) located on the bottom of the connector body. Page 1717 5. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove TPA from the connector. 6. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Page 6220 The first connector design of the Micro-Pack 100W (1) has a white connector interface that holds the terminals. The second design of the Micro-Pack 100W (2) has a gray interface to hold the terminals. Also, the first design has terminal cavities that are further apart (3 mm centerline) and offset from the other row of terminal cavities in the connector. The second design has terminals cavities that are closer together (2.54 mm centerline) and aligned vertically. One other way to identify the second design is the thin strip of material that runs along the outside of the cavities. IMPORTANT: There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W terminals which are very similar. Ensure that you have the correct terminal before crimping the new terminal to the wire. The first design connector uses the longer terminal (1) that has a raised area in front of the recess in the terminal. The second design connector uses the shorter terminal without the raised area. Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro-Pack 100W connectors. Some Micro-Pack 100W connector disassembly procedures will vary. Use this procedure as a guide. 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. Diagram Information and Instructions Radiator Cooling Fan Motor: Diagram Information and Instructions Electrical Symbols Page 608 Body Control Module: Diagrams Body Control Module (BCM) C2 Body Control Module (BCM) C2 Page 1241 Turn Signal/Multifunction Switch C4 (With RPO Code K34) Page 6891 5. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove TPA from the connector. 6. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Page 3662 Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Wheel Hub, Bearing, and Seal Replacement (RWD) Removal Procedure 1. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 2. Remove the tire and wheel. Refer to Tire and Wheel Removal and Installation. 3. Remove the brake rotor. Refer to Front Brake Rotor Replacement. 4. Remove the ABS sensor mounting bolt from the wheel hub and bearing. 5. Remove the ABS sensor from the wheel hub and bearing. 6. Remove the wheel hub and bearing to the steering knuckle mounting bolts. 7. Remove the wheel hub and bearing from the steering knuckle. 8. Remove the splash shield from the steering knuckle. Installation Procedure Page 8639 Page 7978 Cooling System, A/C - Aluminum Heater Cores/Radiators Radiator: Technical Service Bulletins Cooling System, A/C - Aluminum Heater Cores/Radiators INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 05-06-02-001A Date: July 16, 2008 Subject: Information On Aluminum Heater Core and/or Radiator Replacement Models: 2005 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2003-2005 HUMMER H2 Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the Warranty Information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 05-06-02-001 (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). Important: 2004-05 Chevrolet Aveo (Pontiac Wave, Canada Only) does not use DEX-COOL(R). Refer to the flushing procedure explained later in this bulletin. The following information should be utilized when servicing aluminum heater core and/or radiators on repeat visits. A replacement may be necessary because erosion, corrosion, or insufficient inhibitor levels may cause damage to the heater core, radiator or water pump. A coolant check should be performed whenever a heater core, radiator, or water pump is replaced. The following procedures/ inspections should be done to verify proper coolant effectiveness. Caution: To avoid being burned, do not remove the radiator cap or surge tank cap while the engine is hot. The cooling system will release scalding fluid and steam under pressure if the radiator cap or surge tank cap is removed while the engine and radiator are still hot. Important: If the vehicle's coolant is low, drained out, or the customer has repeatedly added coolant or water to the system, then the system should be completely flushed using the procedure explained later in this bulletin. Technician Diagnosis ^ Verify coolant concentration. A 50% coolant/water solution ensures proper freeze and corrosion protection. Inhibitor levels cannot be easily measured in the field, but can be indirectly done by the measurement of coolant concentration. This must be done by using a Refractometer J 23688 (Fahrenheit scale) or J 26568 (centigrade scale), or equivalent, coolant tester. The Refractometer uses a minimal amount of coolant that can be taken from the coolant recovery reservoir, radiator or the engine block. Inexpensive gravity float testers (floating balls) will not completely analyze the coolant concentration fully and should not be used. The concentration levels should be between 50% and 65% coolant concentrate. This mixture will have a freeze point protection of -34 degrees Fahrenheit (-37 degrees Celsius). If the concentration is below 50%, the cooling system must be flushed. ^ Inspect the coolant flow restrictor if the vehicle is equipped with one. Refer to Service Information (SI) and/or the appropriate Service Manual for component location and condition for operation. ^ Verify that no electrolysis is present in the cooling system. This electrolysis test can be performed before or after the system has been repaired. Use a digital voltmeter set to 12 volts. Attach one test lead to the negative battery post and insert the other test lead into the radiator coolant, making sure the lead does not touch the filler neck or core. Any voltage reading over 0.3 volts indicates that stray current is finding its way into the coolant. Electrolysis is often an intermittent condition that occurs when a device or accessory that is mounted to the radiator is energized. This type of current could be caused from a poorly grounded cooling fan or some other accessory and can be verified by watching the volt meter and turning on and off various accessories or engage the starter motor. Before using one of the following flush procedures, the coolant recovery reservoir must be removed, drained, cleaned and reinstalled before refilling the system. Notice: ^ Using coolant other than DEX‐COOL(R) may cause premature engine, heater core or radiator corrosion. In addition, the engine coolant may require changing sooner, at 30,000 miles (50,000 km) or 24 months, whichever occurs first. Any repairs would not be covered by your warranty. Always use DEX‐COOL(R) (silicate free) coolant in your vehicle. ^ If you use an improper coolant mixture, your engine could overheat and be badly damaged. The repair cost would not be covered by your warranty. Too much water in the mixture can freeze and crack the engine, radiator, heater core and other parts. Page 1517 Page 1766 6. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by pressing on the tang. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (SENSOR) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) tool into the cavity on the lower right hand face of the connector until the terminal release tang access panel slides over. Page 9047 Release the lower wiredress cover locking tab. Release the upper wiredress cover locking tab. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. Page 8889 Page 698 IMPORTANT: Ensure that the dress cover and connector body are both in the released position before reassembling. Failure to do so may cause damage to the connector and component. Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (0.64) BOSCH CONNECTORS (0.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While pressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock until the lever is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Pull the rubber boot that covers the wires back to expose the end of the connector dress cover. 4. Place the connector locking lever in the center of the connector. 5. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs that are on the wire end of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover and connector body and pry up. Page 6340 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) and slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. Page 3289 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry one side of the nose piece up to the pre-stage position. When the nose piece is in the pre-staged position, the nose piece will be raised above the connector body the length of the step in the nose piece. 7. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry the other side of the piece to the pre-stage position. If the nose piece is higher than the first step in the nose piece, gently push down on the nose piece until it meets with resistance from the connector body, you should feel the nose piece click into position. Page 3292 3. Remove the dress cover by using a flat-blade tool to release the connector locking tabs and pulling off the dress cover. 4. Relieve the tension on the nose piece retainers by inserting J-38125-12A (12094429) into the single retainer slot on the end of the nose piece and gently prying out the locking tab. Repeat the process for both of the nose piece locking tabs on the opposite side of the nose piece. Page 5702 The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors. 1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position. 4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool J 38125-10A (GM P/N 12014012-1) into the front (mating end) of the connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal through the back of the connector (2). IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector. 6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. 7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily. 10. Perform system check. Delphi Connectors (12 Way) DELPHI CONNECTORS (12-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. Page 5890 US English/Metric Conversion US English/Metric Conversion Page 4108 under pressure if the radiator cap or the surge tank cap is removed while the engine and radiator are still hot. 4. Remove the surge tank fill cap from the surge tank or the coolant pressure cap from the radiator. 5. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle in SI. 6. Place a clean drain pan under the radiator drain cock or under the lower radiator hose depending on the vehicle. Refer to Cooling System Draining and Filling in SI. 7. Loosen the radiator drain cock if equipped or use J 38185 clamp pliers and reposition the clamp on the lower radiator hose at the radiator. 8. Remove the end of the lower radiator hose from the radiator. 9. Drain the engine coolant sufficiently below the level of the ECT sensor. 10. Close the radiator drain cock or connect the lower radiator hose at the radiator. 11. Use the J 38185 clamp pliers to place the clamp into the original position on the hose. 12. Lower the vehicle. 13. Disconnect the wiring harness connector from the ECT sensor (2). 14. Remove the ECT sensor (1) from the front of the cylinder head. 15. Remove the corresponding size plug at the rear of the OTHER cylinder head. 16. Coat the threads of the ECT sensor with sealer. Use GM P/N 12346004 (Canadian P/N 10953480) or an equivalent. 17. Install the ECT sensor in the hole of the cylinder head where the plug was removed. Tighten Tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb ft). 18. Coat the threads of the plug with sealer. Use GM P/N 12346004 (Canadian P/N 10953480) or an equivalent. 19. Install the plug in the hole of the cylinder head where the ECT sensor was removed Tighten Tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb ft). Important Leave enough wire attached to the ECT sensor harness connector in order to create manageable splices that are at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splice. Page 8116 Page 7347 11. Insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) into the 2 triangular cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 12. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE 1. Prior to installation the terminal must be aligned so the (1) coding lugs align with the (2) coding grooves on the connector. 2. Once the terminal is aligned, slide the terminal into the cavity until the retainer has engaged in the cavity of the connector. 3. Slide the TPA in the connector body and seat it using a small flat bladed tool. The TPA is seated when it is flush with the contact housing. 4. Secure the wires to the connector body using a tie wrap and replace the dress cover and grommet. Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) BOSCH CONNECTORS (2.8 JPT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Pull out the slider on the connector position assurance (CPA) until it is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 201 - In some cases Delphi will actually be printed on the connector. If Delphi is not printed on the connector, look for PED. In both cases there is no specific orientation for Delphi or PED and they can appear anywhere on the connector. - FCI connectors may have the FCI logo on their connectors. The logo is the letters FCI with an "A" above it. - JAE connector have JAE in small letters on their connectors. Page 4426 7. The illustration above identifies the entry canal where the terminal release tool will be inserted, and the terminal cavity. - Terminal (1) - Entry Canal (2) 8. Insert the J-38125-553 (15315247) tool into the entry canal and pry up on the terminal retainer. The terminal retainer is a small plastic piece on the top of the terminal. The terminal retainer must be held up while the terminal is pulled out of the connector. Page 4328 4. Install the coolant air bleed covers (313) with seals (308), if necessary. 5. Remove the coolant air bleed pipe cover bolts (312), if necessary. Tighten the bolts to 12 N.m (106 lb in). 6. Install the coolant air bleed hose to the coolant air bleed pipe. 7. Position the coolant air bleed hose clamp at the coolant air bleed pipe. 8. Fill the cooling system, if necessary. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System (LL8) Draining and Filling Cooling System (LH6, LS2). 9. Install the air cleaner resonator outlet duct. Refer to Air Cleaner Resonator Outlet Duct Replacement or Air Cleaner Resonator Outlet Duct Replacement. Page 7647 Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. FCI Connectors FCI CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 3367 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. 4. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front of the connector. Page 819 IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals. Front probe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the connector. IMPORTANT: When probing female 0.64 terminals, it is important to use the correct adapter. There have been some revisions to the test adapter for 0.64 terminals. The proper adapter for 0.64 terminals is the J 35616-64B which has a gold terminal and a black wire between the base and tip. Failure to use the proper test adapter may result in damage to the terminal being tested and improper diagnosis. NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Page 4129 Oil Filter Adapter: Service and Repair Oil Filter Bypass Valve Replacement Oil Filter Bypass Valve Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Remove the oil filter. 2. Remove the oil filter adapter (1). 3. Remove the oil filter bypass valve (2). Installation Procedure Page 6034 Page 4259 Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection Fuel System Diagnosis Fuel System Diagnosis Diagnostic Fault Information Perform the Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle prior to using this diagnostic procedure. Circuit/System Description When the ignition is turned ON, the engine control module (ECM) supplies power to the in-tank fuel pump, by energizing the fuel pump relay. The in-tank fuel pump remains ON as long as the engine is cranking or running and the ECM receives crankshaft reference pulses. If there are no reference pulses, the ECM turns the in-tank fuel pump OFF, 2 seconds after the ignition switch is turned ON or 2 seconds after the engine stops running. The electric fuel pump is incorporated into the modular fuel pump and sender assembly and is located inside the fuel tank. The fuel pump supplies fuel through a fuel filter, also located in the modular fuel pump and sender assembly, through the fuel feed pipes, to the fuel rail assembly. The fuel pump provides fuel at a pressure above the pressure needed by the fuel injectors. The fuel pressure regulator, located in the modular fuel pump and sender assembly, keeps the fuel available to the fuel injectors at a regulated pressure. When the fuel pressure rises above the pressure regulator calibration, the pressure is relieved, with excess fuel exhausted into the modular fuel pump and sender assembly reservoir. Circuit/System Verification Important: * Inspect the fuel system for damage or external leaks before proceeding. * Verify that adequate fuel is in the fuel tank before proceeding. * The fuel pump relay may need to be commanded ON a few times in order to obtain the highest possible fuel pressure. Ignition ON, command the fuel pump relay ON with a scan tool. You should hear the fuel pump turn ON and OFF. ‹› If the fuel pump does not operate, refer to Fuel Pump Electrical Circuit Diagnosis. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics * Ignition OFF, all accessories OFF, install the J34730-1A. Refer to Fuel Pressure Gage Installation and Removal. * Ignition ON, command the fuel pump relay ON with a scan tool. Verify the fuel pressure is between 345-414 kPa (50-60 psi) and remains steady for 5 minutes. Circuit/System Testing Important: * The fuel pump relay may need to be commanded ON a few times in order to obtain the highest possible fuel pressure. * DO NOT start the engine. Ignition ON, command the fuel pump relay ON with a scan tool and observe the fuel pressure gage while the fuel pump is operating. Verify the fuel pressure is between 345-414 kPa (50-60 psi). ‹› If the fuel pressure is greater than the specified range, replace the fuel pump. ‹› If the fuel pressure is less than the specified range, remove the fuel tank and test, inspect, and repair the items listed below. If all items test normal, replace the fuel pump. * Restricted fuel feed pipe * Restricted or plugged fuel filter * Restricted or plugged strainer * Stuck or binding fuel level float * Inspect the harness connectors and the ground circuits of the fuel pump for poor connections. Important: The fuel pressure may vary slightly when the fuel pump stops operating. After the fuel pump stops operating, the fuel pressure should stabilize and remain constant. * Verify that the fuel pressure does not decrease more than 34 kPa (5 psi) in 1 minute. ‹› If the fuel pressure decreases more than the specified value, perform the following procedure: Page 2612 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. 4. Remove the dress cover by using a flat bladed tool to release the dress cover locking tabs and lift up on the dress cover. 5. Cut the tie wrap that holds the wires to the connector body. Page 4837 7. The illustration above identifies the entry canal where the terminal release tool will be inserted, and the terminal cavity. - Terminal (1) - Entry Canal (2) 8. Insert the J-38125-553 (15315247) tool into the entry canal and pry up on the terminal retainer. The terminal retainer is a small plastic piece on the top of the terminal. The terminal retainer must be held up while the terminal is pulled out of the connector. Page 1459 2. Locate the nose piece locking tabs that are positioned on the side of the connector nose piece. The connector nose piece acts as a terminal positive assurance (TPA) and may be referred to as such. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to push in one of the locking tabs while gently pulling on the same side of the nose piece. 4. Repeat the procedure for the other locking tab and remove the nose piece. 5. Remove the wire dress cover. The following is a general procedure for wire dress cover removal. Use this procedure as a guide, some dress cover removal procedures may vary. 6. Use fingers to squeeze the 2 locking legs of the cover. Page 5707 REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. The release tab is located on the top of the wiredress cover. View of connector in released position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Page 6336 pulling it through. This will prevent damage to the internal seals of the connector. Once the terminal is pushed out of the connector, cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible and pull the wire through the connector. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE The Micro-Pack 100W connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool was developed to crimp Micro-Pack 100W terminals. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 2. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert the terminal into the crimp tool until the core wings are flush with the anvil on the crimp tool. Be sure that the wings are pointed toward the crimp tool former and release the spring locator. The locator will hold the terminal in place. Inspect the alignment of the terminal wings with the crimp tool former. If the terminal wings are wider than the crimp tool former, remove the terminal and bend the terminal wings in slightly. 5. Place stripped wire into terminal. 6. Crimp the new terminal to the wire. If a jam occurs, press the emergency release to open applicator. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire perform the following procedure in order to replace Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. Page 1699 Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Page 5699 pulling it through. This will prevent damage to the internal seals of the connector. Once the terminal is pushed out of the connector, cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible and pull the wire through the connector. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE The Micro-Pack 100W connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool was developed to crimp Micro-Pack 100W terminals. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 2. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert the terminal into the crimp tool until the core wings are flush with the anvil on the crimp tool. Be sure that the wings are pointed toward the crimp tool former and release the spring locator. The locator will hold the terminal in place. Inspect the alignment of the terminal wings with the crimp tool former. If the terminal wings are wider than the crimp tool former, remove the terminal and bend the terminal wings in slightly. 5. Place stripped wire into terminal. 6. Crimp the new terminal to the wire. If a jam occurs, press the emergency release to open applicator. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire perform the following procedure in order to replace Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. Page 6085 5. Insert the J 38125-557 (GM P/N 12122378) into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 6. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Connector Position Assurance Locks CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of the connector. CPAs are used in various connectors throughout the vehicle. CPAs are also used in all SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals, of the connector. Connector Repairs CONNECTOR REPAIRS Locations Parking Brake Warning Switch: Locations Hydraulic Brake Component Views Park Brake Switch 1 - Park Brake Lever Assembly 2 - Park Brake Switch Page 8777 vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide variety of actions, including: - Wiggling the harness - Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting - Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector - Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation - Relocating a harness or wires All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. Another option is, with the component commanded ON and OFF by the scan tool, move related connectors and wiring and observe the component operation. With the engine running, move related connectors and wiring while monitoring engine operation. If harness or connector movement affects the data displayed, component/system operation, or engine operation, inspect and repair the harness/connections as necessary. You may need to load the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these cases you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide good results as well. There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions, along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the circuit to these kinds of conditions. SALT WATER SPRAY Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture. Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5 percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously. HIGH TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070. Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault condition. The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis. This option does not allow for the same control, however. LOW TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect. If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to -18°C (0°F) from one end and +71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized cooling needs. Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or components in an effort to duplicate the concern. DUPLICATING FAILURE CONDITIONS - If none of the previous tests are successful, attempt to duplicate and/or capture the failure conditions. Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, where applicable, contains the conditions that were present when the DTC set. 1. Review and record Freeze Frame/Failure Records data. 2. Clear the DTCs using the scan tool. 3. Turn the key to OFF and wait 15 seconds. 4. Operate the vehicle under the same conditions that were noted in Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, as closely as possible. The vehicle must also be operating within the Conditions for Running the DTC. Refer to Conditions for Running the DTC in the supporting text if a DTC is being diagnosed. 5. Monitor DTC Status for the DTC being tested. The scan tool will indicate Ran, when the enabling conditions have been satisfied long enough for the DTC to run. The scan tool will also indicate whether the DTC passed or failed. - An alternate method is to drive the vehicle with the DMM connected to a suspected circuit. An abnormal reading on the DMM when the concern occurs, may help you locate the concern. Measuring Frequency Page 7509 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Ensure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the Terminal Removal Procedure. Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PULL TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL If the terminal is visibly damaged or is suspected of having a faulty connection, the terminal should be replaced. Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors: 1. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) device and/or the secondary lock. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component or separate the connectors for in-line connectors. 3. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device. 4. Insert the proper pick or removal tool into the front of the connector body. 5. IMPORTANT: On connectors with more than one terminal the service loop may not be large enough to remove the terminal and crimp on a new one. If the terminal wire does not have a large enough service loop for removal, cut the wire 5 cm (2 in) behind the connector before removal. Grasp the wire at the back of the connector body and gently push the terminal out the front of the connector body. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. If the wire needed to be cut in order to remove the terminal, gently push a small length of the same size wire through the back of the connector cavity until there is enough wire exposed in order to crimp on a new terminal. If the wire was not cut, cut the existing wire as close to the old terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 4. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. TERMINAL INSTALLATION 1. Align the terminal and pull the wire from the back of the connector in order to seat the terminal. 2. If necessary, cut the new wire to proper length and splice with existing circuit. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. 3. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply dielectric grease to the connector. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PUSH TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 5870 View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. View of the release tool being used for the smaller terminals. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (2-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 6476 4. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the rear of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. 5. Once the locking tabs are unlocked, slide the inner connector out of the rear of the connector housing. Page 5669 If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200 DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J 39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected. IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J 39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and maximum (MAX) values measured. 1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of a suspected circuit to the other. 2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J 39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep). IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value in order to record the full change. 5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling the connections or the wiring, test driving, or performing other operations. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions. 6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9. Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist. Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections TESTING FOR INTERMITTENT CONDITIONS AND POOR CONNECTIONS TOOLS REQUIRED - J 35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit - J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit When the condition is not currently present, but is indicated in DTC history, the cause may be intermittent. An intermittent may also be the cause when there is a customer complaint, but the symptom cannot be duplicated. Refer to the Symptom Table of the system that is suspect of causing the condition before trying to locate an intermittent condition. Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the following items: Wiring broken inside the insulation - Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector - Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself, and corrosion in the wire to terminal contact area, etc. - Pierced or damaged insulation can allow moisture to enter the wiring causing corrosion. The conductor can corrode inside the insulation, with little visible evidence. Look for swollen and stiff sections of wire in the suspect circuits. - Wiring which has been pinched, cut, or its insulation rubbed through may cause an intermittent open or short as the bare area touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle. - Wiring that comes in contact with hot or exhaust components - Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required, in order to verify the customer concern. - Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. - Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis and Vehicle Data Recorder operation. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any inline connectors before replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation. Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination, usually in the underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit. Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper adapter. Always use the J 35616 when probing connectors. Other causes of terminal deformation are improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT IN BUSSED ELECTRICAL CENTERS (BEC) Page 480 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (BSK) BOSCH CONNECTORS (BSK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 3. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 4. Insert the J 38125-561 tool into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 5. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is Page 5856 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 6014 breakers are used. CIRCUIT BREAKER This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high current is removed. POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) CIRCUIT BREAKER This type greatly increases its resistance when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker will re-close within a second or 2. Circuit Protection - Fuses CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSES The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and examine the element in the fuse for an open (2). If not broken (1), also check for continuity using a DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one of equal current rating. Circuit Protection - Fusible Links CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSIBLE LINKS Page 3004 Allow at least a two hour soak time between engine OFF and start up when evaluating the tick noise. 2. Start the engine and evaluate the valve lifter tick noise. ‹› If the valve lifter tick noise is still present, replace all 16 valve lifters. Refer to Valve Lifter Replacement in SI. Parts Information Note A V8 AFM engine requires 8 AFM lifters and 8 non-AFM lifters for a total of 16 lifters. Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use: Warranty Information (Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 1361 View of typical connector. View of connector in released position. 1. Locate the assist lever at the back of the connector. Move the assist lever to the rear position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the dress cover. Page 6969 Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair Mass Airflow Sensor/Intake Air Temperature Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure Important: Use care when handling the mass air flow (MAF)/intake air temperature (IAT) sensor. Do not dent, puncture, or otherwise damage the honeycell located at the air inlet end of the MAF/IAT. Do not touch the sensing elements or allow anything including cleaning solvents and lubricants to come in contact with them. Use a small amount of a non-silicone based lubricant, on the air duct only, to aid in installation. 1. Disconnect the MAF/IAT sensor electrical connector. 2. Loosen the clamps at the MAF/IAT sensor and the throttle body. 3. Remove the air cleaner outlet duct bolt. 4. Remove the air cleaner outlet duct. 5. Loosen the clamp attaching the MAF/IAT sensor to the air cleaner housing. 6. Remove the MAF/IAT sensor from the air cleaner housing. Installation Procedure Important: The embossed arrow on the MAF/IAT sensor indicates the proper air flow direction. The arrow must point toward the engine. Page 3225 Page 7797 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. JST Connectors JST CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, remove the connector from the component. Page 7216 6. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by pressing on the tang. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (SENSOR) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) tool into the cavity on the lower right hand face of the connector until the terminal release tang access panel slides over. Page 7546 2. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully push the terminal position assurance (TPA) towards the face of the connector on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA is fragile and may break if not done carefully. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. 3. Use the J 38125-215 tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 5810 3. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. View showing depressing of the lever lock release tab. Page 8497 1 - Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor 2 - Knock Sensor (KS) 2 - Right 3 - Engine Harness 4 Starter 5 - Engine Relay Replacement (Attached to Wire Harness) Power Distribution Relay: Service and Repair Relay Replacement (Attached to Wire Harness) RELAY REPLACEMENT (ATTACHED TO WIRE HARNESS) REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the relay. 2. Remove any fasteners which hold the relay in place. 3. Remove any connector position assurance (CPA) devices or secondary locks. 4. IMPORTANT: Use care when removing a relay in a wiring harness when the relay is secured by fasteners or tape. Separate the relay (1) from the wire harness connector (2). INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 1. Connect the relay (1) to the wire harness connector (2). 2. Install any connector position assurance (CPA) devices or secondary locks. 3. Install the relay using any fasteners or tape that originally held the relay in place. Page 3229 Utility/Van Zoning UTILITY/VAN ZONING Page 6498 11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the solder equipment. 12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. 13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to cover the first piece of tape. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE SLEEVES TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit IMPORTANT: Use only dura seal splice sleeves. Other splice sleeves may not protect the splice from moisture or provide a good electrical connection. Use duraseal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. Use duraseal splice sleeves where there is special requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire using duraseal splice sleeves. Page 1460 7. Apply pressure and gently rock the cover until one locking leg is unseated. 8. Continue to apply pressure and rock the cover until the second locking leg is unseated. Repeat procedure for the other side of the dress cover and remove the cover. 9. Use J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) to gently lift the terminal retaining tab while gently pulling the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 10. If the terminal is severely bent or damaged, it may be possible on some connectors to push the wire out of the front of the connector instead of Page 7651 2. Locate the two indents of the terminal position assurance (TPA) located on the bottom of the connector body. Page 2639 Open the harness by removing any tape. 2. Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. 3. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 4. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent american wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 5. Slide a section of high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing down the length of wire to be spliced. Ensure that the shrink tubing will not interfere with the splice procedure. 6. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 7. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. 8. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 9. Insert the wire into the DuraSeal splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 10. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Page 3305 View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. View of the release tool being used for the smaller terminals. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (2-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 6258 View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. View of the release tool being used for the smaller terminals. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (2-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 8665 difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Bosch Connectors (ECM) BOSCH CONNECTORS (ECM) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the assist lever on the top of the connector. Move the assist lever to the forward position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 8425 View of typical connector. View of connector in released position. 1. Locate the assist lever at the back of the connector. Move the assist lever to the rear position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the dress cover. Page 6198 3. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. View showing depressing of the lever lock release tab. Page 3297 7. Pressing the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool in the release cavity of the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and crimper in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (DOOR MODULE) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Side view of connector. View of top of connector. 1. Locate the assist lever and lock on the top of the connector. Page 3040 Heater Hose: Service and Repair Heater Outlet Hose Replacement (LH6) Heater Outlet Hose Replacement (LH6) Engine - MIL ON P0116/P1400 Set In Very Cold Temps Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Customer Interest Engine - MIL ON P0116/P1400 Set In Very Cold Temps TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 10-06-04-008A Date: January 24, 2011 Subject: Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) Illuminated at Very Cold Ambient Temperatures When Using Engine Coolant Heater, DTC P0116 and/or P1400 Set (Relocate Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor and Engine Coolant Heater Cord) Models: 2006-2007 Buick Rainier 2009 Buick LaCrosse Super, Allure Super (Canada Only) 2006-2010 Cadillac Escalade 2006-2007 Chevrolet Monte Carlo 2006-2009 Chevrolet Impala SS, TrailBlazer 2006-2010 Chevrolet Avalanche, Express, Silverado Tahoe 2006-2009 GMC Envoy 2006-2010 GMC Savana, Sierra, Yukon 2006-2008 Pontiac Grand Prix 2006-2009 Saab 9-7X Equipped with V8 Engine RPO LC9, LH6, LH8, LH9, L76, LS2, LS4, LFA, LZ1, L92, L94, L9H or L20, L96, LMF, LMG, LY2, LY5, LY6 Please Refer to GMVIS Attention: To properly correct this condition, you must follow both of the procedures to relocate the ECT sensor and the engine coolant heater cord. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add cast iron block engine RPOs and to update the Warranty Information coverage period. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 10-06-04-008 (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). Condition Some customers may comment that the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) illuminates after starting the vehicle when they were using the engine coolant heater in very cold ambient temperatures. This usually occurs in a range of -23 to -40°C (-10 to -40°F) or colder. The technician may observe on a scan tool DTC P0116 and/or P1400 set as Current or in History. Cause This condition may be caused by the engine control module (ECM) determining that the ignition OFF time requirement has been met at start-up and interpreting the temperature difference between the engine coolant temperature (ECT) sensor and the intake air temperature (IAT) sensor as being outside of a calibrated range. Correction Important DO NOT replace the ECM for this condition. Relocating the ECT Sensor 1. Turn ON the ignition with the engine OFF. 2. Perform the diagnostic system check - vehicle. Refer to Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle in SI. ‹› If DTC P0116 and/or P1400 are set and the customer WAS using the engine coolant heater, proceed to Step 3. ‹› If DTC P0116 and/or P1400 are set and the customer WAS NOT using the engine coolant heater, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle in SI. 3. Turn OFF the ignition. Warning To avoid being burned, do not remove the radiator cap or surge tank cap while the engine is hot. The cooling system will release scalding fluid and steam Page 5824 - JST connectors have JST in small letters on their connectors, similar to that above. The location of the logo will vary with the connector size and style. - Kostel has an "LK" with a circle around it. These connector are usually used as a transmissions connection and are currently use on some Cadillac vehicles. Page 5743 The engine harness may be repaired using the J-38125. High Temperature Wiring Repairs HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperatures, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time may use materials i.e. wires, connectors, and shielding that has a higher heat rating than typical wiring. When making a repair in a high temperature area observe the following: Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature to replace any damaged wire. - Replace any heat shielding that is removed. - Cover any DuraSeal splice sleeves with SCT1 shrink tubing (available in the J-38125 Terminal Repair kit). - After making a wiring repair, ensure that the location of the wiring is not moved closer to the heat source. IDENTIFYING HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperature, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time need special considerations when making wiring repairs. Areas that may be exposed to higher temperatures can be identified by heat resistant materials that are being used in those areas. These materials may include heat reflective tape, moon tape, and high temperature shrink tubing. Also conduit and other protective coverings may be used. Because conduit or similar coverings are used throughout the vehicle regardless of the temperature, it may be necessary for the technician to determine if an area is exposed to excessive heat before making a wiring repair. Obvious areas of consideration would be any area located near the exhaust manifolds, catalytic converter, and exhaust pipes. The J-38125 contains much of the material you will need to perform repairs on areas exposed to high heat. The kit contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves to crimp and seal connections - High temperature SCT1 shrink tubing to protect the splice sleeves - A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct crimp tool to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools to remove the terminals from the connectors The J-38125 does not contain wire that is suitable to high temperature exposure. Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature of the same or larger gage size as the original wire when repair damage wire. Also replace any reflective tape that you remove during the repair. HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature rating of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125 and then encapsulate the splice sleeve using the high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the order listed. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip keeping all of the wire strands intact. Page 3386 7. Apply pressure and gently rock the cover until one locking leg is unseated. 8. Continue to apply pressure and rock the cover until the second locking leg is unseated. Repeat procedure for the other side of the dress cover and remove the cover. 9. Use J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) to gently lift the terminal retaining tab while gently pulling the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 10. If the terminal is severely bent or damaged, it may be possible on some connectors to push the wire out of the front of the connector instead of Page 2674 Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Inflatable Restraint Vehicle Rollover Sensor Replacement Inflatable Restraint Vehicle Rollover Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure Caution: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. 1. Disable the SIR system. Refer to SIR Disabling and Enabling. 2. Fold back the rear carpet in order to gain access to the sensor. Refer to Rear Floor Panel Carpet Replacement. 3. Disconnect the electrical connector. 4. Remove the nuts securing the rollover sensor to the floor panel. Installation Procedure Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 1. Install the nuts securing the rollover sensor to the floor panel. Tighten the screws to 10 N.m (88 lb in). 2. Connect the electrical connectors. 3. Install the rear carpet. 4. Enable the SIR system. Refer to SIR Disabling and Enabling. Page 348 Locations Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS) Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS) 1 - VSS Sensor 2 - Transfer Case Electronic Components Page 680 Checking Aftermarket Accessories CHECKING AFTERMARKET ACCESSORIES Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits: - CAUTION: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol. - NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice. OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol. Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the cause of the problems. Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include: Power feeds connected to points other than the battery - Antenna location - Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring - Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line - Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories. Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions INDUCING INTERMITTENT FAULT CONDITIONS TOOLS REQUIRED J 25070 Heat Gun Many intermittent open or shorted circuits are affected by harness/connector movement that is caused by vibration, engine torque, bumps/rough pavement, etc. In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness if the malfunction appears to be Page 8479 Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair Fuel Sender Assembly Replacement Fuel Sender Assembly Replacement Tools Required J45722 Fuel Tank Sending Unit Wrench Removal Procedure 1. Remove the fuel tank. 2. Remove the fuel feed (1) and EVAP (2) lines from the fuel sender assembly. Notice: Avoid damaging the lock ring. Use only J-45722 to prevent damage to the lock ring. Notice: Do Not handle the fuel sender assembly by the fuel pipes. The amount of leverage generated by handling the fuel pipes could damage the joints. Important: Do NOT use impact tools. Significant force will be required to release the lock ring. The use of a hammer and screwdriver is not recommended. Secure the fuel tank in order to prevent fuel tank rotation. 3. Use the J45722 and a long breaker-bar in order to unlock the fuel sender lock ring. Turn the fuel sender lock ring in a counterclockwise direction. Page 8797 5. Insert the J 38125-557 (GM P/N 12122378) into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 6. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Connector Position Assurance Locks CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of the connector. CPAs are used in various connectors throughout the vehicle. CPAs are also used in all SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals, of the connector. Connector Repairs CONNECTOR REPAIRS Page 3425 2. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully push the terminal position assurance (TPA) towards the face of the connector on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA is fragile and may break if not done carefully. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. 3. Use the J 38125-215 tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 5472 3. Use a small flat-bladed tool to gently pry off the dress cover by inserting the tool under the cover opposite the harness side and prying up. 4. Remove the cover. 5. Using a small flat-bladed tool, push on the side of the nose piece retainer while pushing the nose piece forward with your thumb. This will release the terminal position assurance (TPA). 6. Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) into the corresponding terminal release cavity. The release cavities are the 2 center rows of cavities on one half of the connector. Page 8556 4. Use a small flat-blade tool to slide the terminal position assurance (TPA) up one notch on both ends of the connector. The TPA is located underneath the wire dress cover. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 318 4. Install the ground, then the washer and then the bolt to the frame. Important: It is important to use the bolts, washers and nuts specified in this bulletin. These parts have been identified due to their conductive finish. 5. Install a washer and nut to the back side of the frame. Tighten Tighten the nut to 9 Nm (79 lb in). 6. Cover the front and back side of the repair area using Rubberized Undercoating. An additional check can be made to ensure a good connection for the battery cable to frame ground. It is possible for this ground to cause similar symptoms with the ABS as described above. *We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may be available from other sources. Parts Information Warranty Information Disclaimer Page 329 4. Install the ground, then the washer and then the bolt to the frame. Important: It is important to use the bolts, washers and nuts specified in this bulletin. These parts have been identified due to their conductive finish. 5. Install a washer and nut to the back side of the frame. Tighten Tighten the nut to 9 Nm (79 lb in). 6. Cover the front and back side of the repair area using Rubberized Undercoating. An additional check can be made to ensure a good connection for the battery cable to frame ground. It is possible for this ground to cause similar symptoms with the ABS as described above. *We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may be available from other sources. Parts Information Warranty Information Disclaimer Page 455 Page 2030 4. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the rear of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. 5. Once the locking tabs are unlocked, slide the inner connector out of the rear of the connector housing. Page 7536 2. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 1286 Behind Left Headlamp Page 8380 to analyze the data during the time a vehicle condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a trigger point that you have determined. Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2 snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a first-in, first-out basis. If a third snapshot is taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost. Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types: Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice - Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200 frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not lost if the Scan Tool is powered down. The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis. The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected values by plotting 3 parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful, especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC. Testing for a Short to Voltage TESTING FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4. Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt, there is a short to voltage in the circuit. Testing for Continuity TESTING FOR CONTINUITY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6. Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit. 7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity. With a Test Lamp IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits. 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6. If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity. Testing for Electrical Intermittents TESTING FOR ELECTRICAL INTERMITTENTS Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment. - Testing for Short to Ground - Testing for Continuity - Testing for a Short to Voltage Page 9070 2. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 9046 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) and slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. Page 3789 6. Gently pry the plastic terminal retainer down and carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (16-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, pull the two connector halves apart. Page 6592 2. Use a small flat-bladed tool to release the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting the tool in the small recess on the side of the connector and pushing up until the TPA releases from the connector body. The TPA should raise just slightly. Do not try to remove the TPA. IMPORTANT: The TPA on this connector cannot be removed unless the terminals are removed first. The TPA will come out of the connector body, but only slightly. When the TPA is slightly raised the terminals can be removed. Using excessive force to remove the TPA with the terminals still in the connector will damage the connector. 3. Repeat the process for the other side of the connector. 4. Ensure that the TPA is in the proper position to remove the terminals. Air Suspension Sensor - LR Ride Height Sensor: Diagrams Air Suspension Sensor - LR Air Suspension Sensor - LR Air Suspension Sensor - LR Page 1495 Release the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the blue locking tabs on both ends of the connector. Gently slide the TPA up to the released position on both ends. 6. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-13A (GM P/N 12031876-1) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. Page 2424 Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Page 2428 IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals. Front probe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the connector. IMPORTANT: When probing female 0.64 terminals, it is important to use the correct adapter. There have been some revisions to the test adapter for 0.64 terminals. The proper adapter for 0.64 terminals is the J 35616-64B which has a gold terminal and a black wire between the base and tip. Failure to use the proper test adapter may result in damage to the terminal being tested and improper diagnosis. NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Page 7584 Step 1 - Step 4 The number below refers to the step number on the diagnostic table. 4. If the battery positive voltage and ground circuits of the DLC are functioning properly, the malfunction must be due to the scan tool. Scan Tool Does Not Communicate with Class 2 Device (5.3L) SCAN TOOL DOES NOT COMMUNICATE WITH CLASS 2 DEVICE (5.3L) CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION Modules connected to the class 2 serial data circuit monitor for serial data communications during normal vehicle operation. Operating information and commands are exchanged among the modules. Connecting a scan tool to the data link connector (DLC) allows communication with the modules for diagnostic purposes. DTCs may be set due to this symptom and during this diagnostic procedure. Complete the diagnostic procedure in order to ensure all the DTCs are diagnosed and cleared from memory. TEST DESCRIPTION Page 3804 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches, and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original. - The wires insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the possibility of fuel contact. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1). 5. Select the proper duraseal splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool. Refer to the Crimp and Seal Splice Table. 6. Place the duraseal splice sleeve in the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115) crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 7. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to hold the duraseal splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 8. Insert the wires into the duraseal splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel in order to prevent the wire from passing through the splice (3). 9. Close the handles of the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115), until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is applied to the splice sleeve. 10. Shrink the insulation around the splice. - Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. - Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Splicing Inline Harness Diodes SPLICING INLINE HARNESS DIODES Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure. 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode. 2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool. 5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode. Page 6924 View of typical connector. View of connector in released position. 1. Locate the assist lever at the back of the connector. Move the assist lever to the rear position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the dress cover. Page 538 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert a small flat-blade tool in the slot below the front loaded terminal position assurance (TPA) and pry up. 3. Remove the TPA by pulling it out of the connector. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-553 (GM P/N 15315247) on a slight upward angle into the cavity below the terminal to be removed. Ensure that the pointed on the end of the tool is facing the bottom of the terminal and it stays in contact with the terminal until it stops on the plastic terminal retainer. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 3457 Fuse Block - Underhood, Top View (5.3L/6.0L) Fuse Block - Underhood, Bottom View Page 6200 Release the tabs that are holding the wiredress cover to the connector body. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the slots on both ends of the connector body. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. J 38125-216 can also be used to remove the nose piece. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by lifting the terminal retaining tabs on the inside of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 7610 If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200 DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J 39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected. IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J 39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and maximum (MAX) values measured. 1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of a suspected circuit to the other. 2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J 39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep). IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value in order to record the full change. 5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling the connections or the wiring, test driving, or performing other operations. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions. 6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9. Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist. Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections TESTING FOR INTERMITTENT CONDITIONS AND POOR CONNECTIONS TOOLS REQUIRED - J 35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit - J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit When the condition is not currently present, but is indicated in DTC history, the cause may be intermittent. An intermittent may also be the cause when there is a customer complaint, but the symptom cannot be duplicated. Refer to the Symptom Table of the system that is suspect of causing the condition before trying to locate an intermittent condition. Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the following items: Wiring broken inside the insulation - Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector - Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself, and corrosion in the wire to terminal contact area, etc. - Pierced or damaged insulation can allow moisture to enter the wiring causing corrosion. The conductor can corrode inside the insulation, with little visible evidence. Look for swollen and stiff sections of wire in the suspect circuits. - Wiring which has been pinched, cut, or its insulation rubbed through may cause an intermittent open or short as the bare area touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle. - Wiring that comes in contact with hot or exhaust components - Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required, in order to verify the customer concern. - Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. - Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis and Vehicle Data Recorder operation. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any inline connectors before replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation. Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination, usually in the underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit. Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper adapter. Always use the J 35616 when probing connectors. Other causes of terminal deformation are improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT IN BUSSED ELECTRICAL CENTERS (BEC) Page 6647 Page 8935 REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. The release tab is located on the top of the wiredress cover. View of connector in released position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Locations Parking Brake Warning Switch: Locations Hydraulic Brake Component Views Park Brake Switch 1 - Park Brake Lever Assembly 2 - Park Brake Switch Page 1611 2. Locate the two indents of the terminal position assurance (TPA) located on the bottom of the connector body. Page 8569 3. Remove the dress cover by using a flat-blade tool to release the connector locking tabs and pulling off the dress cover. 4. Relieve the tension on the nose piece retainers by inserting J-38125-12A (12094429) into the single retainer slot on the end of the nose piece and gently prying out the locking tab. Repeat the process for both of the nose piece locking tabs on the opposite side of the nose piece. Page 2916 * Inspect for evidence of improper arcing. - Measure the gap between the center electrode (4) and the side electrode (3). - Inspect for the correct spark plug torque. - Inspect for signs of tracking that occurred near the insulator tip instead of the center electrode (4). - Inspect for a broken or worn side electrode (3). - Inspect for a broken, worn, or loose center electrode (4) by shaking the spark plug. * A rattling sound indicates internal damage. * A looses center electrode (4) reduces the spark intensity. - Inspect for bridged electrodes (3,4). Deposits on the electrodes (3,4) reduce or eliminates the gap. - Inspect for worn or missing platinum pads on the electrodes (3,4), if equipped. - Inspect for excessive fouling. * Inspect the spark plug recess area of the cylinder head for debris. Dirty or damaged threads can cause the spark plug not to seat correctly during installation. Visual Inspection * Normal operation - Brown to grayish-tan with small amounts of white powdery deposits are normal combustion by-products from fuels with additives. * Carbon fouled - Dry, fluffy black carbon, or soot caused by the following conditions: - Rich fuel mixtures * Leaking fuel injectors * Excessive fuel pressure * Restricted air filter element * Incorrect combustion - Reduced ignition system voltage output * Weak ignition coils * Worn ignition wires * Incorrect spark plug gap - Excessive idling or slow speeds under light loads can keep spark plug temperatures so low that normal combustion deposits may not burn off. * Deposit fouling - Oil, coolant, or additives that include substances such as silicone, very white coating, reduces the spark plug intensity. Most powdery deposits will not affect spark plug intensity unless they form into a glazing over the electrode. Page 8683 The first connector design of the Micro-Pack 100W (1) has a white connector interface that holds the terminals. The second design of the Micro-Pack 100W (2) has a gray interface to hold the terminals. Also, the first design has terminal cavities that are further apart (3 mm centerline) and offset from the other row of terminal cavities in the connector. The second design has terminals cavities that are closer together (2.54 mm centerline) and aligned vertically. One other way to identify the second design is the thin strip of material that runs along the outside of the cavities. IMPORTANT: There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W terminals which are very similar. Ensure that you have the correct terminal before crimping the new terminal to the wire. The first design connector uses the longer terminal (1) that has a raised area in front of the recess in the terminal. The second design connector uses the shorter terminal without the raised area. Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro-Pack 100W connectors. Some Micro-Pack 100W connector disassembly procedures will vary. Use this procedure as a guide. 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 1090 Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Diagrams Hydraulic Brake Connector End Views Brake Fluid Level Switch Page 6275 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches, and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original. - The wires insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the possibility of fuel contact. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1). 5. Select the proper duraseal splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool. Refer to the Crimp and Seal Splice Table. 6. Place the duraseal splice sleeve in the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115) crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 7. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to hold the duraseal splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 8. Insert the wires into the duraseal splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel in order to prevent the wire from passing through the splice (3). 9. Close the handles of the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115), until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is applied to the splice sleeve. 10. Shrink the insulation around the splice. - Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. - Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Splicing Inline Harness Diodes SPLICING INLINE HARNESS DIODES Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure. 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode. 2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool. 5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode. Page 6066 MEASURING FREQUENCY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal. IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM to autorange to an appropriate range. 1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency measured. Measuring Voltage MEASURING VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit. 1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods: - Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. - Turn ON the engine. - Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls. - Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested. 3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The DMM displays the voltage measured at that point. Measuring Voltage Drop MEASURING VOLTAGE DROP NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points. Probing Electrical Connectors PROBING ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS Page 6060 All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system. Page 2123 7. Apply pressure and gently rock the cover until one locking leg is unseated. 8. Continue to apply pressure and rock the cover until the second locking leg is unseated. Repeat procedure for the other side of the dress cover and remove the cover. 9. Use J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) to gently lift the terminal retaining tab while gently pulling the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 10. If the terminal is severely bent or damaged, it may be possible on some connectors to push the wire out of the front of the connector instead of Page 8356 Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagrams Engine Controls Connector End Views Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor Page 1963 TPMS System - Service And Re-Learning Sensor IDs Tire Pressure Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins TPMS System - Service And Re-Learning Sensor IDs INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 10-03-16-001 Date: July 19, 2010 Subject: TPMS System Service and Re-Learning Sensor IDs Models: 2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2 2009 and Prior HUMMER H3 2010 and Prior Saturn Models 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X with Wheel-Mounted Tire Pressure Sensors In the event that the spare tire, which is normally not equipped with a tire pressure monitor (TPM) sensor, is installed in place of one of the road tires and the vehicle is driven above 40 km/h (25 mph) for 20 minutes or more, the TPM indicator icon on the instrument panel cluster (IPC) will flash for approximately one minute and then remain on steady each time the ignition is turned ON, indicating a diagnostic trouble code (DTC) has been set. The driver information center (DIC), if equipped, will also display a SERVICE TIRE MONITOR type message. When the road tire is repaired and reinstalled in the original location, the TPM indicator icon illumination and DIC message may remain displayed until the DTC is cleared. To ensure that the TPM indicator and the DIC message are cleared after service, it is necessary to clear any TPM DTCs using a scan tool. If a scan tool is unavailable, performing the TPM relearn procedure using a TPM diagnostic tool will provide the same results. It is advised to perform the relearn procedure away from other vehicles to prevent picking up a stray sensor signal. If one or more of the TPM sensors are missing or damaged and have been replaced, then the relearn procedure must be performed. Disclaimer Page 4121 Oil Filter: Service and Repair Engine Oil and Oil Filter Replacement Removal Procedure Important: In order to completely drain the oil from the oil pan internal baffling, the bottom of the oil pan must be level during the oil drain procedure. 1. Open the hood. 2. Remove the oil fill cap. 3. Raise and suitably support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 4. Place a oil drain pan under the oil pan drain plug. 5. Remove the oil pan drain plug. 6. Drain the engine oil. 7. Remove the oil filter from the oil pan. 8. Inspect the old oil filter to ensure that the filter seal is not left on the oil pan. Page 6331 4. Once the front 2 locks are unlocked, lift the front of the dress cover and pull it forward. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the small slot on the TPA and pushing down until the TPA releases. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to angle or rock the J 38125-21 tool when inserting it into the connector or the tool may break. Insert the J 38125-21 (GM P/N 15381651-2) tool into the round canal between the terminals cavities at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to repair Micro 64 connector terminals. The Micro 64 connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-64 (M jaw) was developed to crimp Micro 64 terminals. The J 38125-64 crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. The J 38125-64 crimping tool is also designed to crimp both the wire and the insulation at the same time. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro 64 terminals. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. 1. Cut the wire as close to the damaged terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. Page 2509 If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the DuraSeal splice sleeves. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: - Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. - Do not use the crimp and DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 to crimp DuraSeal splice sleeve. In order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 7818 3. Ensure that the terminal release tang access panel is in the correct location to access the terminals. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) into the terminal release tang access slot located behind the access panel of the connector and press down on the terminal while carefully pulling the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Tyco/AMP Connectors (0.25 Cap) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (025 CAP) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component by pressing down on the connector position assurance (CPA). Page 8258 Connector Anatomy Connector Repairs contains a list of all connector repairs. The connector repairs are listed by the connector manufacturer and then by connector type. If the technician cannot identify the manufacturer of the connector, refer to Identifying Connectors below. Knowing the connector manufacturer will assist in finding the correct connector repair from the following list: - Connector Position Assurance Locks - Terminal Position Assurance Locks - Bosch Connectors (0.64) Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) Bosch Connectors (BSK) Bosch Connectors (ECM) - Delphi Connectors (Micro.64) Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) Delphi Connectors (12-Way) - Tyco/AMP Connectors (CM 42-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) Tyco/AMP Connectors (025 Cap) Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) - Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) - Repairing Connector Terminals IDENTIFYING CONNECTORS Knowing the connector manufacturer is helpful when trying to locating the correct connector repair procedure. There are many different connector designs used on GM vehicles and it is sometimes difficult to identify the connector manufacturer. The information in this document should help with the identification of connector manufactures. The following connector manufacturers make most of the connectors found in GM vehicles: AFL/EPC (Alcoa Fujikura Ltd./Engineered Plastics Components) - Bosch - Delphi - FCI (Framatome Connectors International) - JAE (Japan Aviation Electronics) - JST (Japan Solderless Terminals) Page 5755 Page 2443 IMPORTANT: Ensure that the dress cover and connector body are both in the released position before reassembling. Failure to do so may cause damage to the connector and component. Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (0.64) BOSCH CONNECTORS (0.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While pressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock until the lever is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Pull the rubber boot that covers the wires back to expose the end of the connector dress cover. 4. Place the connector locking lever in the center of the connector. 5. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs that are on the wire end of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover and connector body and pry up. Page 3109 Fluid - A/T: Fluid Type Specifications AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION DEXRON-VI Automatic Transmission Fluid. Page 404 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully raise the TPA on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA cannot be removed from the connector while there are terminals present in the connector body. View of the TPA when removed from the connector body. 4. Use the J 38125-12A tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the left side of the terminal release cavity as shown in the graphic. Use the tool to move the terminal release to the right with a gentle prying motion. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 3997 Step 11 - Step 17 Page 2938 Drive Belt: Testing and Inspection Drive Belt Rumbling and Vibration Diagnosis Drive Belt Rumbling and Vibration Diagnosis Diagnostic Aids The accessory drive components can have an affect on engine vibration. Vibration from the engine operating may cause a body component or another part of the vehicle to make rumbling noise. Vibration can be caused by, but not limited to the A/C system over charged, the power steering system restricted or the incorrect fluid, or an extra load on the generator. To help identify an intermittent or an improper condition, vary the loads on the accessory drive components. The drive belt may have a rumbling condition that can not be seen or felt. Sometimes replacing the drive belt may be the only repair for the symptom. If replacing the drive belt, completing the diagnostic table, and the noise is only heard when the drive belts are installed, there might be an accessory drive component with a failure. Varying the load on the different accessory drive components may aid in identifying which component is causing the rumbling noise. Test Description The numbers below refer to the step numbers on the diagnostic table. 2. This test is to verify that the symptom is present during diagnosing. Other vehicle components may cause a similar symptom. 3. This test is to verify that one of the drive belts is causing the rumbling noise or vibration. Rumbling noise may be confused with an internal engine noise due to the similarity in the description. Remove only one drive belt at a time if the vehicle has multiple drive belts. When removing the drive belts the water pump may not be operating and the engine may overheat. Also DTCs may set when the engine is operating with the drive belts removed. 4. Inspecting the drive belts is to ensure that they are not causing the noise. Small cracks across the ribs of the drive belt will not cause the noise. Belt separation is identified by the plys of the belt separating and may be seen at the edge of the belt our felt as a lump in the belt. 5. Small amounts of pilling is normal condition and acceptable. When the pilling is severe the drive belt does not have a smooth surface for proper operation. 9. Inspecting of the fasteners can eliminate the possibility that the wrong bolt, nut, spacer, or washer was installed. 11. This step should only be performed if the water pump is driven by the drive belt. Inspect the water pump shaft for being bent. Also inspect the water pump bearings for smooth operation and excessive play. Compare the water pump with a known good water pump. 12. Accessory drive component brackets that are bent, cracked, or loose may put extra strain on that accessory component causing it to vibrate. Page 3738 Connector Anatomy Connector Repairs contains a list of all connector repairs. The connector repairs are listed by the connector manufacturer and then by connector type. If the technician cannot identify the manufacturer of the connector, refer to Identifying Connectors below. Knowing the connector manufacturer will assist in finding the correct connector repair from the following list: - Connector Position Assurance Locks - Terminal Position Assurance Locks - Bosch Connectors (0.64) Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) Bosch Connectors (BSK) Bosch Connectors (ECM) - Delphi Connectors (Micro.64) Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) Delphi Connectors (12-Way) - Tyco/AMP Connectors (CM 42-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) Tyco/AMP Connectors (025 Cap) Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) - Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) - Repairing Connector Terminals IDENTIFYING CONNECTORS Knowing the connector manufacturer is helpful when trying to locating the correct connector repair procedure. There are many different connector designs used on GM vehicles and it is sometimes difficult to identify the connector manufacturer. The information in this document should help with the identification of connector manufactures. The following connector manufacturers make most of the connectors found in GM vehicles: AFL/EPC (Alcoa Fujikura Ltd./Engineered Plastics Components) - Bosch - Delphi - FCI (Framatome Connectors International) - JAE (Japan Aviation Electronics) - JST (Japan Solderless Terminals) Page 2571 Release the tabs that are holding the wiredress cover to the connector body. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the slots on both ends of the connector body. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. J 38125-216 can also be used to remove the nose piece. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by lifting the terminal retaining tabs on the inside of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 5215 2. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 189 View of connector in released position. 4. Disconnect the connector from the component. 5. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Release the rear lower half of the wiredress cover. Page 6494 If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs SIR/SRS WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS, and the wiring components, such as connectors and terminals. IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system terminals. Use either an SIR/SRS pigtail or a terminated lead from the SIR Repair Kit Tray. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves, in order to repair the SIR/SRS wiring - A special crimping tool - A heat torch - An instruction manual The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides the necessary low resistance contact integrity for these sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors SIR/SRS CONNECTOR REPAIR (PLASTIC BODY AND TERMINAL METAL PIN) The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made with a special plating. This plating provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. Use the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit for repairing SIR/SRS terminals and connectors. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the repair kit. The J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit contains: Various terminated leads for sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) terminal replacement - Various connector positive assurance (CPA) locks for SIR/SRS connectors - Base of steering column pigtail connectors part number 12085514 - Yellow vinyl electrical tape Pigtail repair packs are available for SIR/SRS connectors with eight or less terminals. Only the connector body is available for connectors with more than eight terminals. The terminated leads in the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit can be used to replace damaged terminals when replacing the connector body. SIR/SRS COMPONENT WIRE PIGTAIL REPAIR IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails. A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device, not by a connector. If a wiring pigtail is damaged, you must replace the entire component, with pigtail. The inflatable restraint steering wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component. SIR/SRS WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 6684 - Yazaki has a wedge or arrow shape, similar to that shown. Delphi Connectors (Micro .64) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro 64 connectors. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. The lever lock may be located on the top or sides of the wire dress cover. Page 7034 - Kostel - Molex - Sumitomo - Tyco/AMP - Yazaki Identifying the manufacturer of a connector is often difficult. When trying to determine the manufacturer of a connector, look for specific identifying marks that are unique to that connector supplier. Most of these identify marks are hard to find or see. Check the connector carefully and refer to the information below for pictures and descriptions of connector identification markings. - Most of AFLs connectors have EPC on their connector body. Some of the smaller connectors will not have any markings on them. - In some cases Bosch will actually be printed on the connector. If Bosch does not appear on the connector, look for the Bosch logo. The Bosch logo is a circle with a blunted arrow inside. This logo can appear anywhere on the connector and is often very small. Page 7672 2. Use a small flat-bladed tool to release the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting the tool in the small recess on the side of the connector and pushing up until the TPA releases from the connector body. The TPA should raise just slightly. Do not try to remove the TPA. IMPORTANT: The TPA on this connector cannot be removed unless the terminals are removed first. The TPA will come out of the connector body, but only slightly. When the TPA is slightly raised the terminals can be removed. Using excessive force to remove the TPA with the terminals still in the connector will damage the connector. 3. Repeat the process for the other side of the connector. 4. Ensure that the TPA is in the proper position to remove the terminals. Page 3585 Acceptably Prepared (Cleaned-Up) Wheel Surface 6. Once the corrosion has been eliminated, you should coat the repaired area with a commercially available tire sealant such as Patch Brand Bead Sealant or equivalent. Commercially available bead sealants are black rubber-like coatings that will permanently fill and seal the resurfaced bead seat. At 21°C (70°F) ambient temperature, this sealant will set-up sufficiently for tire mounting in about 10 minutes.Coated and Sealed Bead Seat 7. Remount the tire and install the repaired wheel and tire assembly. Refer to Tire and Wheel Removal and Installation in SI. Parts Information Patch Brand Bead Sealer is available from Myers Tires at 1-800-998-9897 or on the web at www.myerstiresupply.com. The one-quart size can of sealer will repair about 20 wheels. Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use: Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table above. Page 504 TERMINAL REMOVAL Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors. 1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA) device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1). 3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 4. Gently pull the cable and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector. 5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal, refer to Terminal Repair. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3. Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector. REINSTALLING TERMINAL 1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly, refer to Wiring Repairs. 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3. Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) DELPHI CONNECTORS (WEATHER PACK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 2355 Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. FCI Connectors FCI CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 5737 2. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully push the terminal position assurance (TPA) towards the face of the connector on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA is fragile and may break if not done carefully. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. 3. Use the J 38125-215 tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 8861 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the DuraSeal splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of a connector. CPAs are used in all SIR System connectors and also in some connectors of other systems. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals of a connection. TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE CLIPS IMPORTANT: When making a splice in an area that may be exposed to moisture use a crimp and seal splice sleeve instead of a Splice Clip. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. Page 8691 Release the lower wiredress cover locking tab. Release the upper wiredress cover locking tab. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. Page 5223 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert a small flat-blade tool in the slot below the front loaded terminal position assurance (TPA) and pry up. 3. Remove the TPA by pulling it out of the connector. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-553 (GM P/N 15315247) on a slight upward angle into the cavity below the terminal to be removed. Ensure that the pointed on the end of the tool is facing the bottom of the terminal and it stays in contact with the terminal until it stops on the plastic terminal retainer. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 7506 2. Locate the nose piece locking tabs that are positioned on the side of the connector nose piece. The connector nose piece acts as a terminal positive assurance (TPA) and may be referred to as such. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to push in one of the locking tabs while gently pulling on the same side of the nose piece. 4. Repeat the procedure for the other locking tab and remove the nose piece. 5. Remove the wire dress cover. The following is a general procedure for wire dress cover removal. Use this procedure as a guide, some dress cover removal procedures may vary. 6. Use fingers to squeeze the 2 locking legs of the cover. Page 492 - Most Molex connectors will have the Molex logo on the dresscover of the connector. In some cases the connectors may have MX followed by another letter. The third letter indicates where the connector was made. A connector with MXD is a Molex connector made in Detroit. Sumitomo has a unique symbol on their connector and possibly a part number. The symbol is similar to that of a diamond lying on its side, similar to that shown. The logo could appear anywhere but the most common place is at the wire side of the housing. Tyco/AMP has many different and unique connector designs. Some may or may not have identifiable marks on them. Page 1383 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert a small flat-blade tool in the slot below the front loaded terminal position assurance (TPA) and pry up. 3. Remove the TPA by pulling it out of the connector. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-553 (GM P/N 15315247) on a slight upward angle into the cavity below the terminal to be removed. Ensure that the pointed on the end of the tool is facing the bottom of the terminal and it stays in contact with the terminal until it stops on the plastic terminal retainer. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 8421 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. JST Connectors JST CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, remove the connector from the component. Page 6455 REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. The release tab is located on the top of the wiredress cover. View of connector in released position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Page 5091 Remove all rust from the ground terminal, the cylinder head and the retaining nut or bolt. Position the main engine wiring harness ground terminal and install the nut or bolt. Tighten: Tighten the retaining nut or bolt to 16 N.m (12 lb ft). Apply some type of electrical moisture sealant to protect the harness terminal from further corrosion. Disclaimer Page 2376 2. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. Diagrams Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Diagrams Engine Controls Connector End Views Mass Air Flow (MAF)/Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON Air Filter Element: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-013B Date: February 01, 2007 INFORMATION Subject: Automatic Transmission Shift, Engine Driveability Concerns or Service Engine Soon (SES) Light On as a Result of the Use of an Excessively/Over-Oiled Aftermarket, Reusable Air Filter Models: 2007 and Prior GM Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2007 and Prior Saturn Models 2003-2007 HUMMER H2 2006-2007 HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 04-07-30-013A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle). The use of an excessively/over-oiled aftermarket, reusable air filter may result in: Service Engine Soon (SES) light on Transmission shift concerns, slipping and damaged clutch(es) or band(s) Engine driveability concerns, poor acceleration from a stop, limited engine RPM range The oil that is used on these air filter elements may be transferred onto the Mass Air Flow (MAF) sensor causing contamination of the sensor. As a result, the Grams per Second (GPS) signal from the MAF may be low and any or all of the concerns listed above may occur. When servicing a vehicle with any of these concerns, be sure to check for the presence of an aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter. The MAF, GPS reading should be compared to a like vehicle with an OEM air box and filter under the same driving conditions to verify the concern. The use of an aftermarket reusable air filter DOES NOT void the vehicle's warranty. If an aftermarket reusable air filter is used, technicians should inspect the MAF sensor element and the air induction hose for contamination of oil prior to making warranty repairs. Transmission or engine driveability concerns (related to the MAF sensor being contaminated with oil) that are the result of the use of an aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter are not considered to be warrantable repair items. Page 7616 View of connector in released position. 4. Disconnect the connector from the component. 5. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Release the rear lower half of the wiredress cover. Page 5566 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the TPA. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the nose piece. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. Page 3330 Fuse Block - Underhood (5.3L/6.0L), Label Usage Page 882 6. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by pressing on the tang. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (SENSOR) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) tool into the cavity on the lower right hand face of the connector until the terminal release tang access panel slides over. Page 7363 pulling it through. This will prevent damage to the internal seals of the connector. Once the terminal is pushed out of the connector, cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible and pull the wire through the connector. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE The Micro-Pack 100W connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool was developed to crimp Micro-Pack 100W terminals. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 2. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert the terminal into the crimp tool until the core wings are flush with the anvil on the crimp tool. Be sure that the wings are pointed toward the crimp tool former and release the spring locator. The locator will hold the terminal in place. Inspect the alignment of the terminal wings with the crimp tool former. If the terminal wings are wider than the crimp tool former, remove the terminal and bend the terminal wings in slightly. 5. Place stripped wire into terminal. 6. Crimp the new terminal to the wire. If a jam occurs, press the emergency release to open applicator. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire perform the following procedure in order to replace Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. Page 208 4. Once the front 2 locks are unlocked, lift the front of the dress cover and pull it forward. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the small slot on the TPA and pushing down until the TPA releases. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to angle or rock the J 38125-21 tool when inserting it into the connector or the tool may break. Insert the J 38125-21 (GM P/N 15381651-2) tool into the round canal between the terminals cavities at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to repair Micro 64 connector terminals. The Micro 64 connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-64 (M jaw) was developed to crimp Micro 64 terminals. The J 38125-64 crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. The J 38125-64 crimping tool is also designed to crimp both the wire and the insulation at the same time. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro 64 terminals. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. 1. Cut the wire as close to the damaged terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. Page 6832 Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair Fuel Pressure Gage Installation and Removal Fuel Pressure Gage Installation and Removal Tools Required CH-48027 Digital Pressure Gage Installation Procedure Caution: Refer to Gasoline/Gasoline Vapors Caution. Caution: Remove the fuel tank cap and relieve the fuel system pressure before servicing the fuel system in order to reduce the risk of personal injury. After you relieve the fuel system pressure, a small amount of fuel may be released when servicing the fuel lines, the fuel injection pump, or the connections. In order to reduce the risk of personal injury, cover the fuel system components with a shop towel before disconnection. This will catch any fuel that may leak out. Place the towel in an approved container when the disconnection is complete. 1. Relieve the fuel system pressure. Refer to Fuel Pressure Relief. 2. Connect the CH-48027-1 (1) to the CH-48027-2 (2). 3. Remove the shop towel from around the fuel rail service port, and place in an approved gasoline container. 4. Perform any tests and/or diagnostics as needed. For the proper usage of the CH-48027 , refer to the manufacture's directions. Removal Procedure Page 3049 Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair Suction Screen Installation Suction Screen Installation Tools Required J44551 Suction Screen Kit Important: Suction screens are intended to be installed in the suction hose after a major compressor failure. 1. Using a caliper that reads to 3 decimal places, measure the ID of the suction hose or manifold suction fitting. Refer to the suction screen coverage chart above to determine the correct size screen for the application. 2. Select and install the correct mandrel (1) on the threaded portion of the installation tool bolt. * The brass Universal Mandrel is for use on hose fittings with a smooth bore where the screen installs flush with the end of the fitting. * The 0.471" (11.96 mm) Mandrel is only for the 0.471" (11.96 mm) screen in hose fittings with an internal hourglass shape where the screen installs at the recessed, reduced diameter point. Page 6270 If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs SIR/SRS WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS, and the wiring components, such as connectors and terminals. IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system terminals. Use either an SIR/SRS pigtail or a terminated lead from the SIR Repair Kit Tray. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves, in order to repair the SIR/SRS wiring - A special crimping tool - A heat torch - An instruction manual The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides the necessary low resistance contact integrity for these sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors SIR/SRS CONNECTOR REPAIR (PLASTIC BODY AND TERMINAL METAL PIN) The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made with a special plating. This plating provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. Use the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit for repairing SIR/SRS terminals and connectors. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the repair kit. The J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit contains: Various terminated leads for sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) terminal replacement - Various connector positive assurance (CPA) locks for SIR/SRS connectors - Base of steering column pigtail connectors part number 12085514 - Yellow vinyl electrical tape Pigtail repair packs are available for SIR/SRS connectors with eight or less terminals. Only the connector body is available for connectors with more than eight terminals. The terminated leads in the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit can be used to replace damaged terminals when replacing the connector body. SIR/SRS COMPONENT WIRE PIGTAIL REPAIR IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails. A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device, not by a connector. If a wiring pigtail is damaged, you must replace the entire component, with pigtail. The inflatable restraint steering wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component. SIR/SRS WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 2252 4. Slide the dress cover forward and off of the connector. 5. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front and rear of the connector. Page 4448 11. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 12. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 13. Center the high temperature SCT1 shrink tube over the DuraSeal splice sleeve. 14. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the high temperature heat shrink tubing. 15. Gradually move the heat from the center to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 16. Replace any reflective tape and clips that may have been remove during the repair. Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation REPAIRING DAMAGED WIRE INSULATION Wire Size Conversion Page 7408 Open the harness by removing any tape. 2. Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. 3. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 4. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent american wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 5. Slide a section of high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing down the length of wire to be spliced. Ensure that the shrink tubing will not interfere with the splice procedure. 6. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 7. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. 8. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 9. Insert the wire into the DuraSeal splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 10. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Page 6971 7. Connect the MAF/IAT electrical connector. Page 6766 1. Relieve the fuel system pressure, if required. Perform the following steps: Caution: Wrap a shop towel around the fuel pressure connection in order to reduce the risk of fire and personal injury. The towel will absorb any fuel leakage that occurs during the connection of the fuel pressure gage. Place the towel in an approved container when the connection of the fuel pressure gage is complete. 1. Wrap a shop towel around the fuel rail service port. 2. Place the hose on the CH-48027-2 (2) into an approved gasoline container. 3. Open the valve on the CH-48027-2 (2) in order to bleed any fuel from the fuel rail. 4. Close the valve on the CH-48027-2 (2). 5. Remove the hose on the CH-48027-2 (2) from the approved gasoline container. 6. Remove the shop towel from around the fuel rail service port, and place in an approved gasoline container. Notice: Clean all of the following areas before performing any disconnections in order to avoid possible contamination in the system: * The fuel pipe connections * The hose connections * The areas surrounding the connections Disconnect the CH-48027-1 (1) from the CH-48027-2 (2). 2. Disconnect the CH-48027-2 (2) from the CH-48027-3 (4). 3. Disconnect the CH-48027-3 (4) from the fuel rail service port. 4. Install the fuel rail service port cap. 5. Tighten the fuel fill cap. Page 1854 difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Bosch Connectors (ECM) BOSCH CONNECTORS (ECM) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the assist lever on the top of the connector. Move the assist lever to the forward position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 5152 vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide variety of actions, including: - Wiggling the harness - Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting - Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector - Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation - Relocating a harness or wires All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. Another option is, with the component commanded ON and OFF by the scan tool, move related connectors and wiring and observe the component operation. With the engine running, move related connectors and wiring while monitoring engine operation. If harness or connector movement affects the data displayed, component/system operation, or engine operation, inspect and repair the harness/connections as necessary. You may need to load the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these cases you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide good results as well. There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions, along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the circuit to these kinds of conditions. SALT WATER SPRAY Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture. Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5 percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously. HIGH TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070. Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault condition. The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis. This option does not allow for the same control, however. LOW TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect. If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to -18°C (0°F) from one end and +71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized cooling needs. Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or components in an effort to duplicate the concern. DUPLICATING FAILURE CONDITIONS - If none of the previous tests are successful, attempt to duplicate and/or capture the failure conditions. Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, where applicable, contains the conditions that were present when the DTC set. 1. Review and record Freeze Frame/Failure Records data. 2. Clear the DTCs using the scan tool. 3. Turn the key to OFF and wait 15 seconds. 4. Operate the vehicle under the same conditions that were noted in Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, as closely as possible. The vehicle must also be operating within the Conditions for Running the DTC. Refer to Conditions for Running the DTC in the supporting text if a DTC is being diagnosed. 5. Monitor DTC Status for the DTC being tested. The scan tool will indicate Ran, when the enabling conditions have been satisfied long enough for the DTC to run. The scan tool will also indicate whether the DTC passed or failed. - An alternate method is to drive the vehicle with the DMM connected to a suspected circuit. An abnormal reading on the DMM when the concern occurs, may help you locate the concern. Measuring Frequency Engine - Drive Belt Misalignment Diagnostics Drive Belt: Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Drive Belt Misalignment Diagnostics INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 08-06-01-008A Date: July 27, 2009 Subject: Diagnosing Accessory Drive Belt / Serpentine Belt Noise and Availability and Use of Kent-Moore EN-49228 Laser Alignment Tool - Drive Belt Models: 2010 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3 Vehicles 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add a model year and update the Tool Information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 08-06-01-008 (Section 06 - Engine). Background Several aftermarket companies offer laser alignment tools for accessory drive systems that can be very helpful in eliminating drive belt noise as a result of misaligned pulleys. Typically pricing ranges from $160 - $200. EN-49228 Laser Alignment Tool - Drive Belt The GM Tool program has now made available a competitive, simple to use and time-saving laser tool to assist in achieving precise alignment of the drive belt pulleys. This optional tool removes the guesswork from proper pulley alignment and may serve to reduce comebacks from: - Drive Belt Noise - Accelerated Drive Belt Wear - Drive Belt Slippage Instructions The instructions below are specific only to the truck Gen IV V-8 family of engines. These instructions are only for illustrative purposes to show how the tool may be used. Universal instructions are included in the box with the Laser Alignment Tool - Drive Belt. Caution - Do not look directly into the beam projected from the laser. - Use caution when shining the laser on highly polished or reflective surfaces. Laser safety glasses help reduce laser beam glare in many circumstances. - Always use laser safety glasses when using the laser. Laser safety glasses are not designed to protect eyes from direct laser exposure. 1. Observe and mark the serpentine belt orientation. Page 7715 Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Diagrams Engine Controls Connector End Views Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor Page 5401 Page 5582 3. Remove the dress cover by using a flat-blade tool to release the connector locking tabs and pulling off the dress cover. 4. Relieve the tension on the nose piece retainers by inserting J-38125-12A (12094429) into the single retainer slot on the end of the nose piece and gently prying out the locking tab. Repeat the process for both of the nose piece locking tabs on the opposite side of the nose piece. Page 5428 IMPORTANT: Ensure that the dress cover and connector body are both in the released position before reassembling. Failure to do so may cause damage to the connector and component. Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (0.64) BOSCH CONNECTORS (0.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While pressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock until the lever is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Pull the rubber boot that covers the wires back to expose the end of the connector dress cover. 4. Place the connector locking lever in the center of the connector. 5. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs that are on the wire end of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover and connector body and pry up. Page 7531 5. Once the nose piece retainers are relaxed, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should raise slightly. 6. On the opposite side of the nose piece, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should release completely. If the nose piece does not come off, repeat the procedure on the opposite side. Page 8458 If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs SIR/SRS WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS, and the wiring components, such as connectors and terminals. IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system terminals. Use either an SIR/SRS pigtail or a terminated lead from the SIR Repair Kit Tray. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves, in order to repair the SIR/SRS wiring - A special crimping tool - A heat torch - An instruction manual The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides the necessary low resistance contact integrity for these sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors SIR/SRS CONNECTOR REPAIR (PLASTIC BODY AND TERMINAL METAL PIN) The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made with a special plating. This plating provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. Use the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit for repairing SIR/SRS terminals and connectors. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the repair kit. The J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit contains: Various terminated leads for sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) terminal replacement - Various connector positive assurance (CPA) locks for SIR/SRS connectors - Base of steering column pigtail connectors part number 12085514 - Yellow vinyl electrical tape Pigtail repair packs are available for SIR/SRS connectors with eight or less terminals. Only the connector body is available for connectors with more than eight terminals. The terminated leads in the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit can be used to replace damaged terminals when replacing the connector body. SIR/SRS COMPONENT WIRE PIGTAIL REPAIR IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails. A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device, not by a connector. If a wiring pigtail is damaged, you must replace the entire component, with pigtail. The inflatable restraint steering wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component. SIR/SRS WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 7057 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. JST Connectors JST CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, remove the connector from the component. Page 1371 7. The illustration above identifies the entry canal where the terminal release tool will be inserted, and the terminal cavity. - Terminal (1) - Entry Canal (2) 8. Insert the J-38125-553 (15315247) tool into the entry canal and pry up on the terminal retainer. The terminal retainer is a small plastic piece on the top of the terminal. The terminal retainer must be held up while the terminal is pulled out of the connector. Page 2148 7. The illustration above identifies the entry canal where the terminal release tool will be inserted, and the terminal cavity. - Terminal (1) - Entry Canal (2) 8. Insert the J-38125-553 (15315247) tool into the entry canal and pry up on the terminal retainer. The terminal retainer is a small plastic piece on the top of the terminal. The terminal retainer must be held up while the terminal is pulled out of the connector. Page 1103 Wheel Speed Sensor - LR Wheel Speed Sensor - RF Wheel Speed Sensor - RF Wheel Speed Sensor - RR Page 7585 Step 1 - Step 10 The numbers below refer to the step numbers on the diagnostic table. 2. A current DTC, U1300 or U1301, may be retrieved only from the engine control module (ECM), because the ECM is connected to both class 2 and high speed GMLAN buses, but it communicates with the scan tool on high speed GMLAN bus only. 3. A partial malfunction in the class 2 serial data circuit uses a different procedure from a total malfunction of the class 2 serial data circuit. The scan tool communicates with the following modules on the class 2 serial data circuit: The body control module (BCM) - The communication interface module (OnStar(R)), w/UE1 - The digital radio receiver (DRR), w/U2K - The driver door module (DDM) - The driver seat module (DSM), w/AAB - The DVD player - The electronic brake control module (EBCM) - The end gate module (EGM), for XUV - The HVAC control module - The HVAC control module - rear auxiliary - The inflatable restraint sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) - The instrument panel cluster (IPC) - The liftgate control module (LGM) - The passenger door module (PDM) - The radio - The transfer case shift control module (TCSCM), w/4WD - The theft deterrent control module (VTD), w/BAE Page 5722 5. Once the nose piece retainers are relaxed, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should raise slightly. 6. On the opposite side of the nose piece, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should release completely. If the nose piece does not come off, repeat the procedure on the opposite side. Page 6516 Page 5715 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the rear TPA from the connector. 7. IMPORTANT: The front TPA cannot be removed from the connector. Only move it to the release point. Use a small flat-blade tool to move the front TPA to the release position. 8. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 9. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Molex Connectors Page 1577 Release the tabs that are holding the wiredress cover to the connector body. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the slots on both ends of the connector body. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. J 38125-216 can also be used to remove the nose piece. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by lifting the terminal retaining tabs on the inside of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 4530 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry one side of the nose piece up to the pre-stage position. When the nose piece is in the pre-staged position, the nose piece will be raised above the connector body the length of the step in the nose piece. 7. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry the other side of the piece to the pre-stage position. If the nose piece is higher than the first step in the nose piece, gently push down on the nose piece until it meets with resistance from the connector body, you should feel the nose piece click into position. Page 3732 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. 4. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front of the connector. Page 3748 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert terminal into the appropriate terminal holder until it hits bottom and stops. The correct terminal holder is determined by the wire size. Also ensure that the terminals wings are pointing towards the former on the tool and the release locator. 5. Insert the stripped cable into the terminal. Insulation should be visible on both sides of the terminal insulation wings. 6. Compress the handles until the ratchet automatically releases. 7. Place the terminal into the appropriate cavity and assemble the connector. Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO-PACK 100W) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W connectors. These connectors are very similar but use different terminals and have some minor physical differences also. Page 4980 Page 7364 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Ensure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the Terminal Removal Procedure. Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PULL TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL If the terminal is visibly damaged or is suspected of having a faulty connection, the terminal should be replaced. Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors: 1. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) device and/or the secondary lock. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component or separate the connectors for in-line connectors. 3. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device. 4. Insert the proper pick or removal tool into the front of the connector body. 5. IMPORTANT: On connectors with more than one terminal the service loop may not be large enough to remove the terminal and crimp on a new one. If the terminal wire does not have a large enough service loop for removal, cut the wire 5 cm (2 in) behind the connector before removal. Grasp the wire at the back of the connector body and gently push the terminal out the front of the connector body. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. If the wire needed to be cut in order to remove the terminal, gently push a small length of the same size wire through the back of the connector cavity until there is enough wire exposed in order to crimp on a new terminal. If the wire was not cut, cut the existing wire as close to the old terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 4. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. TERMINAL INSTALLATION 1. Align the terminal and pull the wire from the back of the connector in order to seat the terminal. 2. If necessary, cut the new wire to proper length and splice with existing circuit. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. 3. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply dielectric grease to the connector. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PUSH TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 1648 If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the DuraSeal splice sleeves. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: - Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. - Do not use the crimp and DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 to crimp DuraSeal splice sleeve. In order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 8528 5. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove TPA from the connector. 6. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Page 2552 Page 399 Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. FCI Connectors FCI CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 190 Release the tabs that are holding the wiredress cover to the connector body. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the slots on both ends of the connector body. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. J 38125-216 can also be used to remove the nose piece. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by lifting the terminal retaining tabs on the inside of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 2934 Step 7 - Step 19 Step 20 Page 5841 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the TPA. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the nose piece. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. Page 7150 Checking Aftermarket Accessories CHECKING AFTERMARKET ACCESSORIES Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits: - CAUTION: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol. - NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice. OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol. Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the cause of the problems. Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include: Power feeds connected to points other than the battery - Antenna location - Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring - Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line - Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories. Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions INDUCING INTERMITTENT FAULT CONDITIONS TOOLS REQUIRED J 25070 Heat Gun Many intermittent open or shorted circuits are affected by harness/connector movement that is caused by vibration, engine torque, bumps/rough pavement, etc. In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness if the malfunction appears to be Page 183 If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200 DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J 39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected. IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J 39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and maximum (MAX) values measured. 1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of a suspected circuit to the other. 2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J 39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep). IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value in order to record the full change. 5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling the connections or the wiring, test driving, or performing other operations. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions. 6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9. Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist. Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections TESTING FOR INTERMITTENT CONDITIONS AND POOR CONNECTIONS TOOLS REQUIRED - J 35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit - J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit When the condition is not currently present, but is indicated in DTC history, the cause may be intermittent. An intermittent may also be the cause when there is a customer complaint, but the symptom cannot be duplicated. Refer to the Symptom Table of the system that is suspect of causing the condition before trying to locate an intermittent condition. Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the following items: Wiring broken inside the insulation - Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector - Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself, and corrosion in the wire to terminal contact area, etc. - Pierced or damaged insulation can allow moisture to enter the wiring causing corrosion. The conductor can corrode inside the insulation, with little visible evidence. Look for swollen and stiff sections of wire in the suspect circuits. - Wiring which has been pinched, cut, or its insulation rubbed through may cause an intermittent open or short as the bare area touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle. - Wiring that comes in contact with hot or exhaust components - Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required, in order to verify the customer concern. - Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. - Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis and Vehicle Data Recorder operation. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any inline connectors before replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation. Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination, usually in the underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit. Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper adapter. Always use the J 35616 when probing connectors. Other causes of terminal deformation are improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT IN BUSSED ELECTRICAL CENTERS (BEC) Page 3486 Customer TPMS Information Page 6450 The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors. 1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position. 4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool J 38125-10A (GM P/N 12014012-1) into the front (mating end) of the connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal through the back of the connector (2). IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector. 6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. 7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily. 10. Perform system check. Delphi Connectors (12 Way) DELPHI CONNECTORS (12-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. Page 2096 - A control module from another vehicle is installed. - Revised software/calibration files have been released for this vehicle. - IMPORTANT: DO NOT re-program the control module with the SAME software/calibration files that are already present in the control module. This is not an effective repair for any type of concern. Verify that the control module contains the correct software/calibration. If incorrect programming is found, reprogram the control module with the most current software/calibration. Refer to Control Module References for replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Testing for Short to Ground TESTING FOR SHORT TO GROUND NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 4. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit. With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is a short to ground in the circuit. Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2. Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). - When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. - If the DMM does not display voltage 4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is shorted. Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A DIGITAL MULTIMETER NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the powertrain control module (PCM), should only be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200 Digital Multimeter (DMM). The J 39200 instruction manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminage even though voltage is present. The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity. IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading. Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the measurement. Page 7993 Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested: - Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. - Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a component or to other harnesses. - If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A TEST LAMP TOOLS REQUIRED J 35616-200 Test Light - Probe Kit NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminate even though voltage is present. The J 35616-200 is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair of leads. To properly operate this tool use the following procedures. When testing for voltage: 1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested. When testing for ground: 1. Attach one lead to battery positive voltage. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where ground should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is ground at the point being tested. Using Connector Test Adapters USING CONNECTOR TEST ADAPTERS NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Using Fused Jumper Wires USING FUSED JUMPER WIRES TOOLS REQUIRED J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged. The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested. AFL/ECP Connectors AFL/EPC CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 2464 The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors. 1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position. 4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool J 38125-10A (GM P/N 12014012-1) into the front (mating end) of the connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal through the back of the connector (2). IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector. 6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. 7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily. 10. Perform system check. Delphi Connectors (12 Way) DELPHI CONNECTORS (12-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. Page 266 6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias. Reference the appropriate service manual wiring schematic to obtain the correct diode installation position. 7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for the soldering equipment. 8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed. 9. IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode attachment points with tape. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape. Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable SPLICING TWISTED OR SHIELDED CABLE Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable. 1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splice is made. 3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire. Staggering the splices by 65 mm (2.5 in) is recommended. 4. IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical contact with the drain wire. Re-assemble the cable. Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape. - Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1). - Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire. - Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape. Diagrams Oil Pressure Sender: Diagrams Displays and Gages Connector End Views Engine Oil Pressure (EOP) Sensor (5.3L/6.0L) Page 3434 If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs SIR/SRS WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS, and the wiring components, such as connectors and terminals. IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system terminals. Use either an SIR/SRS pigtail or a terminated lead from the SIR Repair Kit Tray. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves, in order to repair the SIR/SRS wiring - A special crimping tool - A heat torch - An instruction manual The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides the necessary low resistance contact integrity for these sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors SIR/SRS CONNECTOR REPAIR (PLASTIC BODY AND TERMINAL METAL PIN) The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made with a special plating. This plating provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. Use the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit for repairing SIR/SRS terminals and connectors. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the repair kit. The J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit contains: Various terminated leads for sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) terminal replacement - Various connector positive assurance (CPA) locks for SIR/SRS connectors - Base of steering column pigtail connectors part number 12085514 - Yellow vinyl electrical tape Pigtail repair packs are available for SIR/SRS connectors with eight or less terminals. Only the connector body is available for connectors with more than eight terminals. The terminated leads in the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit can be used to replace damaged terminals when replacing the connector body. SIR/SRS COMPONENT WIRE PIGTAIL REPAIR IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails. A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device, not by a connector. If a wiring pigtail is damaged, you must replace the entire component, with pigtail. The inflatable restraint steering wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component. SIR/SRS WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 8160 TERMINAL REMOVAL Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors. 1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA) device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1). 3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 4. Gently pull the cable and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector. 5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal, refer to Terminal Repair. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3. Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector. REINSTALLING TERMINAL 1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly, refer to Wiring Repairs. 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3. Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) DELPHI CONNECTORS (WEATHER PACK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 2771 18. Carefully begin to lower the control valve body down from the transmission case while simultaneously disconnecting the manual valve link. Installation Procedure Ball Check Valves 1. Install the checkballs (1-7) in the valve body. 2. Install the control valve body to the transmission case while simultaneously connecting the manual valve link to the manual valve. 3. Verify that the manual valve link (3) is installed properly to the inside detent lever (1) and the manual valve (2). Brakes - ABS Lamp ON/DTC's C0265/C0201/U1041 Set Electronic Brake Control Module: Customer Interest Brakes - ABS Lamp ON/DTC's C0265/C0201/U1041 Set TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 04-05-25-002E Date: March 11, 2009 Subject: ABS Light On, DTCs C0265, C0201, U1041 Set and/or Loss of Communication with Brake Module (Reground EBCM Ground) Models Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add step 2 to the procedure and update the Parts and Warranty Information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 04-05-25-002D (Section 05 - Brakes). Condition Some customers may comment that the ABS light is on. Upon further inspection, DTCs C0265 and C0201 may be set in the brake module. It is also possible for DTC U1041 to set in other modules. There may also be a loss of communication with the brake module. Cause A poor connection at the EBCM ground is causing unnecessary replacement of brake modules. Important: The EBCM ground is different for each application. Refer to the list below for the proper ground reference: ^ Midsize Utilities = Ground 304 ^ SSR = Ground 400 ^ Fullsize Trucks and Utilities = Ground 110 Correction Important: Do not replace the brake module to correct this condition. Perform the following repair before further diagnosis of the EBCM. Perform the following steps to improve the connection of the EBCM Ground: 1. Remove the EBCM Ground. The EBCM Ground is located on the frame beneath the driver's side door. If multiple grounds are found in this location, the EBCM ground can be identified as the heavy (12-gauge) wire. 2. If the original fastener has a welded on nut, remove the nut from the frame, and if required, enlarge the bolt hole to accommodate the new bolt and nut. 3. Clean the area, front and back, using a tool such as a *3M(TM) Scotch-Brite Roloc disc or equivalent. Page 5565 Release the lower wiredress cover locking tab. Release the upper wiredress cover locking tab. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. Page 807 Page 5951 Release the tabs that are holding the wiredress cover to the connector body. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the slots on both ends of the connector body. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. J 38125-216 can also be used to remove the nose piece. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by lifting the terminal retaining tabs on the inside of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 6157 Page 8945 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. 4. Remove the dress cover by using a flat bladed tool to release the dress cover locking tabs and lift up on the dress cover. 5. Cut the tie wrap that holds the wires to the connector body. Page 3773 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 2576 IMPORTANT: Ensure that the dress cover and connector body are both in the released position before reassembling. Failure to do so may cause damage to the connector and component. Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (0.64) BOSCH CONNECTORS (0.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While pressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock until the lever is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Pull the rubber boot that covers the wires back to expose the end of the connector dress cover. 4. Place the connector locking lever in the center of the connector. 5. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs that are on the wire end of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover and connector body and pry up. Page 1066 Power Seat Switch: Service and Repair Front Seat Lumbar Control Switch Replacement FRONT SEAT LUMBAR CONTROL SWITCH REPLACEMENT REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Remove the switch bezel assembly from the seat. 2. Remove the power seat switch. 3. Release the tabs that retain the lumbar switch to the switch bezel assembly. 4. Disconnect the electrical connector from the lumbar switch. 5. Remove the lumbar switch from the switch bezel assembly. INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 1. Connect the electrical connector to the lumbar switch. 2. Install the lumbar switch to the switch bezel assembly, verifying that the retaining tabs are fully seated. 3. Install the power seat switch. 4. Install the switch bezel assembly to the seat. Page 5538 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (BSK) BOSCH CONNECTORS (BSK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 3. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 4. Insert the J 38125-561 tool into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 5. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is Page 2675 Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Inflatable Restraint Side Impact Sensor Replacement Inflatable Restraint Side Impact Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure Caution: Do not strike or jolt the inflatable restraint side impact sensor (SIS). Before applying power to the SIS make sure that it is securely fastened. Failure to observe the correct installation procedures could cause SIR deployment, personal injury, or unnecessary SIR system repairs. Caution: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. 1. Disable the SIR system. Refer to SIR Disabling and Enabling. 2. Remove the front door trim panel. 3. Peel the rear half of the water deflector away from the door in order to access the side impact sensor. 4. Remove the screws that retain the side impact sensor (2) to the door. 5. Disconnect the impact sensor electrical connector (1) from the side impact sensor. 6. Remove the side impact sensor from the door. Installation Procedure 1. Remove any dirt, grease, or other impurities from the mounting surface. 2. Position the side impact sensor (2) horizontally to the door. 3. Connect the electrical connector (1) to the side impact sensor (2). Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 4. Install the screws which retain the side impact sensor to the door. Tighten the screws to 8 N.m (71 lb in). 5. Fully seat the water deflector to the door. 6. Install the door trim panel. 7. Enable the SIR system. Refer to SIR Disabling and Enabling. Page 5831 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert terminal into the appropriate terminal holder until it hits bottom and stops. The correct terminal holder is determined by the wire size. Also ensure that the terminals wings are pointing towards the former on the tool and the release locator. 5. Insert the stripped cable into the terminal. Insulation should be visible on both sides of the terminal insulation wings. 6. Compress the handles until the ratchet automatically releases. 7. Place the terminal into the appropriate cavity and assemble the connector. Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO-PACK 100W) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W connectors. These connectors are very similar but use different terminals and have some minor physical differences also. Page 2117 View of the connector when released from the component. View of another type of Micro 64 connector. Page 4582 Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay: Diagnostic Aids Arrows and Symbols Arrows and Symbols This Service Data uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations. Arrows and Symbols 1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow Basic Knowledge Required GENERAL ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures contained in the service manual. You should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current (amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram, as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. Decimal and Metric Equivalents Decimal and Metric Equivalents Page 437 Open the harness by removing any tape. 2. Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. 3. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 4. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent american wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 5. Slide a section of high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing down the length of wire to be spliced. Ensure that the shrink tubing will not interfere with the splice procedure. 6. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 7. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. 8. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 9. Insert the wire into the DuraSeal splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 10. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Diagram Information and Instructions Fuse Block: Diagram Information and Instructions Electrical Symbols Page 2032 3. Ensure that the terminal release tang access panel is in the correct location to access the terminals. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) into the terminal release tang access slot located behind the access panel of the connector and press down on the terminal while carefully pulling the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Tyco/AMP Connectors (0.25 Cap) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (025 CAP) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component by pressing down on the connector position assurance (CPA). Page 9025 6. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs located on the opposite side of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover at the connector end and pry up. 7. Remove the dress cover. 8. Cut the tie wrap on the wire bundle. 9. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting a small flat-bladed tool into the small slot in the end of the slider and pushing on the TPA until it comes out of the connector. When the TPA exits the opposite side of the connector, gasp the TPA and pull it completely out of the connector. 10. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 8078 Engine Control Module: Connector Views Engine Control Module Connector End Views Engine Control Module (ECM) C1 Page 2425 Checking Aftermarket Accessories CHECKING AFTERMARKET ACCESSORIES Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits: - CAUTION: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol. - NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice. OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol. Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the cause of the problems. Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include: Power feeds connected to points other than the battery - Antenna location - Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring - Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line - Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories. Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions INDUCING INTERMITTENT FAULT CONDITIONS TOOLS REQUIRED J 25070 Heat Gun Many intermittent open or shorted circuits are affected by harness/connector movement that is caused by vibration, engine torque, bumps/rough pavement, etc. In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness if the malfunction appears to be Page 6721 2. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment Specifications Alignment: Technical Service Bulletins Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment Specifications WARRANTY ADMINISTRATION Bulletin No.: 05-03-07-009C Date: December 09, 2010 Subject: Wheel Alignment Specifications, Requirements and Recommendations for GM Vehicles Models: 2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks Supercede: This bulletin is being extensively revised to provide technicians and warranty administrators with an all inclusive guide for wheel alignments. PLEASE FAMILIARIZE YOURSELF WITH THESE UPDATES BEFORE PERFORMING YOUR NEXT GM WHEEL ALIGNMENT SERVICE. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 05-03-07-009B (Section 03 - Suspension). Purpose The purpose of this bulletin is to provide retail, wholesale and fleet personnel with General Motors' warranty service requirements and recommendations for customer concerns related to wheel alignment. For your convenience, this bulletin updates and centralizes all of GM's Standard Wheel Alignment Service Procedures, Policy Guidelines and bulletins on wheel alignment warranty service. Important PLEASE FAMILIARIZE YOURSELF WITH THESE UPDATES BEFORE PERFORMING YOUR NEXT GM WHEEL ALIGNMENT SERVICE. The following five (5) key steps are a summary of this bulletin and are REQUIRED in completing a successful wheel alignment service. 1. Verify the vehicle is in an Original Equipment condition for curb weight, tires, wheels, suspension and steering configurations. Vehicles modified in any of these areas are not covered for wheel alignment warranty. 2. Review the customer concern relative to "Normal Operation" definitions. 3. Verify that vehicle is within the "Mileage Policy" range. 4. Document wheel alignment warranty claims appropriately for labor operations E2000 and E2020. The following information must be documented or attached to the repair order: - Customer concern in detail - What corrected the customer concern? - If a wheel alignment is performed: - Consult SI for proper specifications. - Document the "Before" AND "After" wheel alignment measurements/settings. - Completed "Wheel Alignment Repair Order Questionnaire" (form attached to this bulletin) 5. Use the proper wheel alignment equipment (preferred with print-out capability), process and the appropriate calibration maintenance schedules. Important If it is determined that a wheel alignment is necessary under warranty, use the proper labor code for the repair. E2000 for Steering Wheel Angle and/or Front Toe set or E2020 for Wheel Alignment Check/Adjust includes Caster, Camber and Toe set (Wheel alignment labor time for other component repairs is to be charged to the component that causes a wheel alignment operation.). The following flowchart is to help summarize the information detailed in this bulletin and should be used whenever a wheel alignment is performed. Page 6661 Refer to the following table as a guide in selecting the correct test adapter for front probing connectors: Backprobe IMPORTANT: Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures. - Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector. - Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large of a test probe. - After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected, test for proper terminal contact. Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the connector. Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure SCAN TOOL SNAPSHOT PROCEDURE Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used Page 3763 2. Locate the two indents of the terminal position assurance (TPA) located on the bottom of the connector body. Page 1424 Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Page 434 If a wire is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm, etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except coaxial. - Do not use the DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent American wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 6031 Page 8402 - Yazaki has a wedge or arrow shape, similar to that shown. Delphi Connectors (Micro .64) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro 64 connectors. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. The lever lock may be located on the top or sides of the wire dress cover. Page 822 If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200 DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J 39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected. IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J 39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and maximum (MAX) values measured. 1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of a suspected circuit to the other. 2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J 39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep). IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value in order to record the full change. 5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling the connections or the wiring, test driving, or performing other operations. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions. 6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9. Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist. Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections TESTING FOR INTERMITTENT CONDITIONS AND POOR CONNECTIONS TOOLS REQUIRED - J 35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit - J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit When the condition is not currently present, but is indicated in DTC history, the cause may be intermittent. An intermittent may also be the cause when there is a customer complaint, but the symptom cannot be duplicated. Refer to the Symptom Table of the system that is suspect of causing the condition before trying to locate an intermittent condition. Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the following items: Wiring broken inside the insulation - Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector - Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself, and corrosion in the wire to terminal contact area, etc. - Pierced or damaged insulation can allow moisture to enter the wiring causing corrosion. The conductor can corrode inside the insulation, with little visible evidence. Look for swollen and stiff sections of wire in the suspect circuits. - Wiring which has been pinched, cut, or its insulation rubbed through may cause an intermittent open or short as the bare area touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle. - Wiring that comes in contact with hot or exhaust components - Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required, in order to verify the customer concern. - Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. - Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis and Vehicle Data Recorder operation. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any inline connectors before replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation. Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination, usually in the underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit. Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper adapter. Always use the J 35616 when probing connectors. Other causes of terminal deformation are improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT IN BUSSED ELECTRICAL CENTERS (BEC) Page 6324 - In some cases Delphi will actually be printed on the connector. If Delphi is not printed on the connector, look for PED. In both cases there is no specific orientation for Delphi or PED and they can appear anywhere on the connector. - FCI connectors may have the FCI logo on their connectors. The logo is the letters FCI with an "A" above it. - JAE connector have JAE in small letters on their connectors. Specifications Idler Pulley: Specifications Drive Belt Idler Pulley Bolt ................................................................................................................... ..................................................... 50 N.m (37 lb ft) Page 2459 2. Locate the nose piece locking tabs that are positioned on the side of the connector nose piece. The connector nose piece acts as a terminal positive assurance (TPA) and may be referred to as such. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to push in one of the locking tabs while gently pulling on the same side of the nose piece. 4. Repeat the procedure for the other locking tab and remove the nose piece. 5. Remove the wire dress cover. The following is a general procedure for wire dress cover removal. Use this procedure as a guide, some dress cover removal procedures may vary. 6. Use fingers to squeeze the 2 locking legs of the cover. A/C - Refrigerant Recovery/Recycling/Equipment Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Refrigerant Recovery/Recycling/Equipment Bulletin No.: 08-01-38-001 Date: January 25, 2008 INFORMATION Subject: Information On New GE-48800 CoolTech Refrigerant Recovery/Recharge Equipment Models: 2008 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Including Saturn) 2008 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X Attention: This bulletin is being issued to announce the release of GM approved Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging Equipment that meets the new Society of Automotive Engineers (SAE) J2788 Refrigerant Recovery Standards. The ACR2000 (J-43600) cannot be manufactured in its current state after December 2007 and will be superseded by GE-48800. The new J2788 standard does not require that GM Dealers replace their ACR2000 units. ACR2000's currently in use are very capable of servicing today's refrigerant systems when used correctly and can continue to be used. Details regarding the new SAE J2788 standard are outlined in GM Bulletin 07-01-38-004. Effective February 1 2008, new A/C Refrigerant Recovery/Recharging equipment (P/N GE-48800) will be released as a required replacement for the previously essential ACR2000 (J-43600). This equipment is SAE J2788 compliant and meets GM requirements for A/C Refrigerant System Repairs on all General Motors vehicles, including Hybrid systems with Polyolester (POE) refrigerant oil. This equipment will not be shipped as an essential tool to GM Dealerships. In addition, this equipment is Hybrid compliant and designed to prevent oil cross contamination when servicing Hybrid vehicles with Electric A/C Compressors that use POE refrigerant oil. The ACR2000 (J-43600) will need to be retrofitted with a J-43600-50 (Hose - ACR2000 Oil Flush Loop) to be able to perform Hybrid A/C service work. All Hybrid dealers will receive the J-43600-50, with installation instructions, as a component of the Hybrid essential tool package. Dealerships that do not sell Hybrids, but may need to service Hybrids, can obtain J-43600-50 from SPX Kent Moore. Refer to GM Bulletin 08-01-39-001 for the ACR2000 Hose Flush procedure. The High Voltage (HV) electric A/C compressor used on Two Mode Hybrid vehicles uses a Polyolester (POE) refrigerant oil instead of a Polyalkylene Glycol (PAG) synthetic refrigerant oil. This is due to the better electrical resistance of the POE oil and its ability to provide HV isolation. Failure to flush the hoses before adding refrigerant to a Hybrid vehicle with an electric A/C compressor may result in an unacceptable amount of PAG oil entering the refrigerant system. It may cause a Battery Energy Control Module Hybrid Battery Voltage System Isolation Lost Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC P1AE7) to be set. Additionally, the A/C system warranty will be voided. Warranty Submission Requirements The Electronically Generated Repair Data (snapshot summary) and printer functions have been eliminated from the GE-48800. The VGA display and temperature probes were eliminated to reduce equipment costs. As a result, effective immediately the 18 digit "Snapshot/Charge Summary" code is no longer required for Air Conditioning (A/C) refrigerant system repairs that are submitted for warranty reimbursement. The charge summary data from before and after system repairs will continue to required, but documented on the repair order only. Both high and low pressures and the recovery and charge amounts should be noted during the repair and entered on the repair order. If using ACR2000 (J-43600), the "Snapshot/Charge Summary" printouts should continue to be attached to the shops copy of the repair order. The labor codes that are affected by this requirement are D3000 through D4500. Disclaimer Page 2310 Page 3988 Disclaimer Page 6545 5. Insert the J 38125-557 (GM P/N 12122378) into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 6. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Connector Position Assurance Locks CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of the connector. CPAs are used in various connectors throughout the vehicle. CPAs are also used in all SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals, of the connector. Connector Repairs CONNECTOR REPAIRS Page 2667 Electronic Frontal Sensor (EFS) - Left Engine - GM dexos 1 and dexos 2(R) Oil Specifications Engine Oil: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - GM dexos 1 and dexos 2(R) Oil Specifications INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 11-00-90-001 Date: March 14, 2011 Subject: Global Information for GM dexos1(TM) and GM dexos2(TM) Engine Oil Specifications for Spark Ignited and Diesel Engines, Available Licensed Brands, and Service Fill for Adding or Complete Oil Change Models: 2012 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks Excluding All Vehicles Equipped with Duramax(TM) Diesel Engines GM dexos 1(TM) Information Center Website Refer to the following General Motors website for dexos 1(TM) information about the different licensed brands that are currently available: http://www.gmdexos.com GM dexos 1(TM) Engine Oil Trademark and Icons The dexos(TM) specification and trademarks are exclusive to General Motors, LLC. Only those oils displaying the dexos‹›(TM) trademark and icon on the front label meet the demanding performance requirements and stringent quality standards set forth in the dexos‹›(TM) specification. Look on the front label for any of the logos shown above to identify an authorized, licensed dexos 1(TM) engine oil. GM dexos 1(TM) Engine Oil Specification Important General Motors dexos 1(TM) engine oil specification replaces the previous General Motors specifications GM6094M, GM4718M and GM-LL-A-025 for most GM gasoline engines. The oil specified for use in GM passenger cars and trucks, PRIOR to the 2011 model year remains acceptable for those previous vehicles. However, dexos 1(TM) is backward compatible and can be used in those older vehicles. In North America, starting with the 2011 model year, GM introduced dexos 1(TM) certified engine oil as a factory fill and service fill for gasoline engines. The reasons for the new engine oil specification are as follows: - To meet environmental goals such as increasing fuel efficiency and reducing engine emissions. - To promote long engine life. - To minimize the number of engine oil changes in order to help meet the goal of lessening the industry's overall dependence on crude oil. dexos 1(TM) is a GM-developed engine oil specification that has been designed to provide the following benefits: - Further improve fuel economy, to meet future corporate average fuel economy (CAFE) requirements and fuel economy retention by allowing the oil to maintain its fuel economy benefits throughout the life of the oil. - More robust formulations for added engine protection and aeration performance. Page 5754 US English/Metric Conversion US English/Metric Conversion Page 8173 4. Slide the dress cover forward and off of the connector. 5. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front and rear of the connector. Page 3752 pulling it through. This will prevent damage to the internal seals of the connector. Once the terminal is pushed out of the connector, cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible and pull the wire through the connector. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE The Micro-Pack 100W connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool was developed to crimp Micro-Pack 100W terminals. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 2. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert the terminal into the crimp tool until the core wings are flush with the anvil on the crimp tool. Be sure that the wings are pointed toward the crimp tool former and release the spring locator. The locator will hold the terminal in place. Inspect the alignment of the terminal wings with the crimp tool former. If the terminal wings are wider than the crimp tool former, remove the terminal and bend the terminal wings in slightly. 5. Place stripped wire into terminal. 6. Crimp the new terminal to the wire. If a jam occurs, press the emergency release to open applicator. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire perform the following procedure in order to replace Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. Page 8161 The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors. 1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position. 4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool J 38125-10A (GM P/N 12014012-1) into the front (mating end) of the connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal through the back of the connector (2). IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector. 6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. 7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily. 10. Perform system check. Delphi Connectors (12 Way) DELPHI CONNECTORS (12-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. Page 4855 If a wire is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm, etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except coaxial. - Do not use the DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent American wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 1276 Turn Signal/Multifunction Switch C2 Page 5661 Page 1762 3. Use a small flat-bladed tool to gently pry off the dress cover by inserting the tool under the cover opposite the harness side and prying up. 4. Remove the cover. 5. Using a small flat-bladed tool, push on the side of the nose piece retainer while pushing the nose piece forward with your thumb. This will release the terminal position assurance (TPA). 6. Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) into the corresponding terminal release cavity. The release cavities are the 2 center rows of cavities on one half of the connector. Page 3802 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link). - The wire insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. 5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold them between thumb and forefinger. 7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place. - Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction. - Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip. 8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool closes.Ensure that no strands of wire are cut. 10. Crimp the splice on each end (2). Page 7788 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Ensure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the Terminal Removal Procedure. Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PULL TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL If the terminal is visibly damaged or is suspected of having a faulty connection, the terminal should be replaced. Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors: 1. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) device and/or the secondary lock. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component or separate the connectors for in-line connectors. 3. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device. 4. Insert the proper pick or removal tool into the front of the connector body. 5. IMPORTANT: On connectors with more than one terminal the service loop may not be large enough to remove the terminal and crimp on a new one. If the terminal wire does not have a large enough service loop for removal, cut the wire 5 cm (2 in) behind the connector before removal. Grasp the wire at the back of the connector body and gently push the terminal out the front of the connector body. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. If the wire needed to be cut in order to remove the terminal, gently push a small length of the same size wire through the back of the connector cavity until there is enough wire exposed in order to crimp on a new terminal. If the wire was not cut, cut the existing wire as close to the old terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 4. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. TERMINAL INSTALLATION 1. Align the terminal and pull the wire from the back of the connector in order to seat the terminal. 2. If necessary, cut the new wire to proper length and splice with existing circuit. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. 3. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply dielectric grease to the connector. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PUSH TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Locations Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Locations Engine Controls Component Views Upper Right Side of the Engine - Front 1 - Engine 2 - Engine Harness 3 - Air Duct 4 - Mass Air Flow (MAF)/Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor Page 1946 Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Heated Oxygen Sensor Replacement - Bank 2 Sensor 1 Heated Oxygen Sensor Replacement - Bank 2 Sensor 1 Removal Procedure Notice: Refer to Heated Oxygen and Oxygen Sensor Notice. Notice: Refer to Excessive Force and Oxygen Sensor Notice. 1. Raise and suitably support the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Unscrew the heated oxygen sensor (HO2S) sensor from the catalytic converter. 3. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) retainer. 4. Disconnect the HO2S electrical connector (2). Installation Procedure Page 4376 Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. For connectors with a bolt in the dress cover, turn the bolt counterclockwise to remove the connector from the component. 2. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. Page 1579 difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Bosch Connectors (ECM) BOSCH CONNECTORS (ECM) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the assist lever on the top of the connector. Move the assist lever to the forward position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 5813 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (BSK) BOSCH CONNECTORS (BSK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 3. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 4. Insert the J 38125-561 tool into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 5. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is Page 6308 - A control module from another vehicle is installed. - Revised software/calibration files have been released for this vehicle. - IMPORTANT: DO NOT re-program the control module with the SAME software/calibration files that are already present in the control module. This is not an effective repair for any type of concern. Verify that the control module contains the correct software/calibration. If incorrect programming is found, reprogram the control module with the most current software/calibration. Refer to Control Module References for replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Testing for Short to Ground TESTING FOR SHORT TO GROUND NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 4. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit. With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is a short to ground in the circuit. Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2. Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). - When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. - If the DMM does not display voltage 4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is shorted. Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A DIGITAL MULTIMETER NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the powertrain control module (PCM), should only be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200 Digital Multimeter (DMM). The J 39200 instruction manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminage even though voltage is present. The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity. IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading. Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the measurement. Page 5031 9. Separate the exhaust hanger insulators from the exhaust system and position the exhaust system rearward for additional clearance. 10. Remove the left exhaust manifold pipe nuts. 11. Remove the right exhaust manifold pipe nuts. 12. Raise the transmission with the transmission jack for additional catalytic converter pipe clearance. 13. Tilt the catalytic converter (1) in order to lower the left side catalytic converter pipe below the vehicle frame. Rotate the catalytic converter outlet pipe toward the left side of the vehicle to gain the necessary clearance for the right side catalytic converter pipe to clear the vehicle frame. Remove the catalytic converter (1) from the vehicle. Page 4303 Spark Plug: Testing and Inspection Spark Plug Inspection * Verify that the correct spark plug is installed. An incorrect spark plug causes driveability conditions. Refer to Ignition System Specifications for the correct spark plug. * Ensure that the spark plug has the correct heat range. An incorrect heat range causes the following conditions: - Spark plug fouling - Colder plug - Pre-ignition causing spark plug and/or engine damage - Hotter plug * Inspect the terminal post (1) for damage. - Inspect for a bent or broken terminal post (1) - Test for a loose terminal post (1) by twisting and pulling the post. The terminal post should not move. * Inspect the insulator (2) for flashover or carbon tracking, or soot. This is caused by the electrical charge traveling across the insulator between the terminal post (1) and ground. Inspect for the following conditions: - Inspect the spark plug boot for damage. - Inspect the spark plug recess are of the cylinder head for moisture, such as oil, coolant, or water. A spark plug boot that is saturated will cause arcing to ground. * Inspect the insulator (2) for cracks. All or part of the electrical charge may arc through the crack instead of the electrodes (3,4). Page 8312 breakers are used. CIRCUIT BREAKER This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high current is removed. POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) CIRCUIT BREAKER This type greatly increases its resistance when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker will re-close within a second or 2. Circuit Protection - Fuses CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSES The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and examine the element in the fuse for an open (2). If not broken (1), also check for continuity using a DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one of equal current rating. Circuit Protection - Fusible Links CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSIBLE LINKS Page 8688 TERMINAL REMOVAL Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors. 1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA) device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1). 3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 4. Gently pull the cable and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector. 5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal, refer to Terminal Repair. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3. Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector. REINSTALLING TERMINAL 1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly, refer to Wiring Repairs. 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3. Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) DELPHI CONNECTORS (WEATHER PACK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 914 normal, replace the ECM. 6. Connect a test lamp between the relay coil B+ and the relay coil control circuit. 7. Ignition ON, command the powertrain relay ON and OFF with a scan tool. The test lamp should turn ON and OFF when changing between the commanded states. ‹› If the test lamp is always ON, test the relay coil control circuit for a short to ground. If the circuit tests normal, replace the ECM. ‹› If the test lamp is always OFF, test the relay coil control circuit for a short to voltage or an open/high resistance. If the circuit tests normal, replace the ECM. 8. Connect a 20A fused jumper wire between the relay switch B+ and the relay ignition 1 voltage circuit. 9. Ignition ON, engine OFF, monitor the EC Ignition Relay Feedback parameter with a scan tool. The parameter should display B+. ‹› If the parameter does not display B+, test the ignition 1 voltage circuit for an open/high resistance. If the circuit tests normal, replace the ECM. 10. If all circuits test normal, test or replace the relay. Component Testing 1. Ignition OFF, disconnect the powertrain relay. 2. Test for 65-110 ohms of resistance between terminals 85 and 86 of the relay. ‹› If the resistance is not within the specified range, replace the relay. 3. Test for infinite resistance between following terminals: * Terminal 30 and 86 * Terminal 30 and 87 * Terminal 30 and 85 * Terminal 85 and 87 ‹› If not the specified value, replace the relay. 4. Install a 20A fused jumper wire between relay terminal 85 and 12 volts. Install a jumper wire between relay terminal 86 and ground. Test for less than 1 ohm of resistance between terminals 30 and 87. ‹› If greater than the specified range, replace the relay. Repair Instructions Perform the Diagnostic Repair Verification after completing the diagnostic procedure. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests and Procedures * Relay Replacement (Attached to Wire Harness) Relay Replacement (Within an Electrical Center) * Underhood Electrical Center or Junction Block Replacement * Control Module References for ECM replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Page 8011 - Yazaki has a wedge or arrow shape, similar to that shown. Delphi Connectors (Micro .64) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro 64 connectors. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. The lever lock may be located on the top or sides of the wire dress cover. Page 4678 Page 4554 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Start in the middle and gradually move the heat barrel to the open ends of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Heated Oxygen Sensor Wiring Repairs HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being obstructed. If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. - Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks, etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire. - Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance. - To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector. Page 9016 Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. For connectors with a bolt in the dress cover, turn the bolt counterclockwise to remove the connector from the component. 2. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. Service and Repair Exhaust Resonator: Service and Repair Resonator Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Raise and suitably support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. Important: Do not reuse any component of the exhaust system that is corroded or damaged. 2. Inspect the exhaust system components to determine if they can be reused. 3. Cut (1) the resonator pipe as close to the exhaust hanger as possible. 4. Separate the resonator and tailpipe assembly from the hanger insulators. 5. Remove the resonator and tailpipe assembly. Installation Procedure 1. Install the new resonator and tailpipe assembly to the muffler. 2. Attach the resonator and tailpipe to the hanger insulators. 3. Loosely install the clamp to secure the resonator to the muffler. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 4. Align the tailpipe in the proper position. Tighten the clamp nuts to 50 N.m (37 lb ft). 5. Inspect the exhaust system for leaks and underbody contact. 6. Lower the vehicle. Page 8908 5. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove TPA from the connector. 6. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Page 5164 Release the tabs that are holding the wiredress cover to the connector body. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the slots on both ends of the connector body. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. J 38125-216 can also be used to remove the nose piece. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by lifting the terminal retaining tabs on the inside of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 8509 Page 8591 The engine harness may be repaired using the J-38125. High Temperature Wiring Repairs HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperatures, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time may use materials i.e. wires, connectors, and shielding that has a higher heat rating than typical wiring. When making a repair in a high temperature area observe the following: Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature to replace any damaged wire. - Replace any heat shielding that is removed. - Cover any DuraSeal splice sleeves with SCT1 shrink tubing (available in the J-38125 Terminal Repair kit). - After making a wiring repair, ensure that the location of the wiring is not moved closer to the heat source. IDENTIFYING HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperature, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time need special considerations when making wiring repairs. Areas that may be exposed to higher temperatures can be identified by heat resistant materials that are being used in those areas. These materials may include heat reflective tape, moon tape, and high temperature shrink tubing. Also conduit and other protective coverings may be used. Because conduit or similar coverings are used throughout the vehicle regardless of the temperature, it may be necessary for the technician to determine if an area is exposed to excessive heat before making a wiring repair. Obvious areas of consideration would be any area located near the exhaust manifolds, catalytic converter, and exhaust pipes. The J-38125 contains much of the material you will need to perform repairs on areas exposed to high heat. The kit contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves to crimp and seal connections - High temperature SCT1 shrink tubing to protect the splice sleeves - A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct crimp tool to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools to remove the terminals from the connectors The J-38125 does not contain wire that is suitable to high temperature exposure. Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature of the same or larger gage size as the original wire when repair damage wire. Also replace any reflective tape that you remove during the repair. HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature rating of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125 and then encapsulate the splice sleeve using the high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the order listed. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip keeping all of the wire strands intact. Page 5725 3. Use a small flat-bladed tool to gently pry off the dress cover by inserting the tool under the cover opposite the harness side and prying up. 4. Remove the cover. 5. Using a small flat-bladed tool, push on the side of the nose piece retainer while pushing the nose piece forward with your thumb. This will release the terminal position assurance (TPA). 6. Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) into the corresponding terminal release cavity. The release cavities are the 2 center rows of cavities on one half of the connector. Body Wiring Harness Extension Replacement Body Control Module: Service and Repair Body Wiring Harness Extension Replacement BODY WIRING HARNESS EXTENSION REPLACEMENT - BCM REMOVAL PROCEDURE IMPORTANT: The ignition switch should be in the OFF position when connecting or disconnecting the connectors to the body control module (BCM). - Always disconnect the 40-way body wiring extension FIRST, the 32-way tan connector SECOND and the 24-way gray electrical connector LAST. - Always connect the 24-way gray electrical connector FIRST, the 32-way tan connector SECOND and the 40-way body wiring extension LAST. - The BCM can set DTCs with the ignition switch in the OFF position. The BCM has battery run down protection for the courtesy lamp circuit. The BCM battery run down protection cannot detect shorts on inputs or other circuits which the BCM does not control. Use the scan tool in order to activate the POWER DOWN NOW mode. Use the POWER DOWN NOW mode in order to check for current draws on circuits that are not controlled by the BCM, or controlled by the battery run down protection system. - Do not touch the exposed electrical contacts of the body wiring extension. 1. CAUTION: Refer to Battery Disconnect Caution. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. If replacing the body wiring harness extension on a Chevrolet Trail Blazer EXT or GMC Envoy XL, remove the left second row seat. 3. If replacing the body wiring harness extension on a Chevrolet TrailBlazer or GMC Envoy, position the left hand second seat to a cargo position. 4. Remove the rear electrical center cover. 5. Press down and hold the locking tab (1). 6. Disengage the sliding latch retaining the BCM to the rear electrical center.Slide the latch inboard until fully extended, approximately 40 mm (1.6 in). 7. Disconnect the body wiring extension (1) from the BCM. Page 6504 Body Wiring Harness Extension Replacement Body Control Module: Service and Repair Body Wiring Harness Extension Replacement BODY WIRING HARNESS EXTENSION REPLACEMENT - BCM REMOVAL PROCEDURE IMPORTANT: The ignition switch should be in the OFF position when connecting or disconnecting the connectors to the body control module (BCM). - Always disconnect the 40-way body wiring extension FIRST, the 32-way tan connector SECOND and the 24-way gray electrical connector LAST. - Always connect the 24-way gray electrical connector FIRST, the 32-way tan connector SECOND and the 40-way body wiring extension LAST. - The BCM can set DTCs with the ignition switch in the OFF position. The BCM has battery run down protection for the courtesy lamp circuit. The BCM battery run down protection cannot detect shorts on inputs or other circuits which the BCM does not control. Use the scan tool in order to activate the POWER DOWN NOW mode. Use the POWER DOWN NOW mode in order to check for current draws on circuits that are not controlled by the BCM, or controlled by the battery run down protection system. - Do not touch the exposed electrical contacts of the body wiring extension. 1. CAUTION: Refer to Battery Disconnect Caution. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. If replacing the body wiring harness extension on a Chevrolet Trail Blazer EXT or GMC Envoy XL, remove the left second row seat. 3. If replacing the body wiring harness extension on a Chevrolet TrailBlazer or GMC Envoy, position the left hand second seat to a cargo position. 4. Remove the rear electrical center cover. 5. Press down and hold the locking tab (1). 6. Disengage the sliding latch retaining the BCM to the rear electrical center.Slide the latch inboard until fully extended, approximately 40 mm (1.6 in). 7. Disconnect the body wiring extension (1) from the BCM. Page 3461 Fuse Block - Underhood C2 Page 6422 3. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. View showing depressing of the lever lock release tab. Page 3465 Fuse Block - Underhood C3 Page 4494 6. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs located on the opposite side of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover at the connector end and pry up. 7. Remove the dress cover. 8. Cut the tie wrap on the wire bundle. 9. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting a small flat-bladed tool into the small slot in the end of the slider and pushing on the TPA until it comes out of the connector. When the TPA exits the opposite side of the connector, gasp the TPA and pull it completely out of the connector. 10. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 1292 Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Diagrams Engine Controls Connector End Views Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor Page 4701 under pressure if the radiator cap or the surge tank cap is removed while the engine and radiator are still hot. 4. Remove the surge tank fill cap from the surge tank or the coolant pressure cap from the radiator. 5. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle in SI. 6. Place a clean drain pan under the radiator drain cock or under the lower radiator hose depending on the vehicle. Refer to Cooling System Draining and Filling in SI. 7. Loosen the radiator drain cock if equipped or use J 38185 clamp pliers and reposition the clamp on the lower radiator hose at the radiator. 8. Remove the end of the lower radiator hose from the radiator. 9. Drain the engine coolant sufficiently below the level of the ECT sensor. 10. Close the radiator drain cock or connect the lower radiator hose at the radiator. 11. Use the J 38185 clamp pliers to place the clamp into the original position on the hose. 12. Lower the vehicle. 13. Disconnect the wiring harness connector from the ECT sensor (2). 14. Remove the ECT sensor (1) from the front of the cylinder head. 15. Remove the corresponding size plug at the rear of the OTHER cylinder head. 16. Coat the threads of the ECT sensor with sealer. Use GM P/N 12346004 (Canadian P/N 10953480) or an equivalent. 17. Install the ECT sensor in the hole of the cylinder head where the plug was removed. Tighten Tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb ft). 18. Coat the threads of the plug with sealer. Use GM P/N 12346004 (Canadian P/N 10953480) or an equivalent. 19. Install the plug in the hole of the cylinder head where the ECT sensor was removed Tighten Tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb ft). Important Leave enough wire attached to the ECT sensor harness connector in order to create manageable splices that are at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splice. Page 1644 The engine harness may be repaired using the J-38125. High Temperature Wiring Repairs HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperatures, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time may use materials i.e. wires, connectors, and shielding that has a higher heat rating than typical wiring. When making a repair in a high temperature area observe the following: Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature to replace any damaged wire. - Replace any heat shielding that is removed. - Cover any DuraSeal splice sleeves with SCT1 shrink tubing (available in the J-38125 Terminal Repair kit). - After making a wiring repair, ensure that the location of the wiring is not moved closer to the heat source. IDENTIFYING HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperature, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time need special considerations when making wiring repairs. Areas that may be exposed to higher temperatures can be identified by heat resistant materials that are being used in those areas. These materials may include heat reflective tape, moon tape, and high temperature shrink tubing. Also conduit and other protective coverings may be used. Because conduit or similar coverings are used throughout the vehicle regardless of the temperature, it may be necessary for the technician to determine if an area is exposed to excessive heat before making a wiring repair. Obvious areas of consideration would be any area located near the exhaust manifolds, catalytic converter, and exhaust pipes. The J-38125 contains much of the material you will need to perform repairs on areas exposed to high heat. The kit contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves to crimp and seal connections - High temperature SCT1 shrink tubing to protect the splice sleeves - A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct crimp tool to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools to remove the terminals from the connectors The J-38125 does not contain wire that is suitable to high temperature exposure. Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature of the same or larger gage size as the original wire when repair damage wire. Also replace any reflective tape that you remove during the repair. HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature rating of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125 and then encapsulate the splice sleeve using the high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the order listed. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip keeping all of the wire strands intact. Page 7983 Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Page 1428 IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals. Front probe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the connector. IMPORTANT: When probing female 0.64 terminals, it is important to use the correct adapter. There have been some revisions to the test adapter for 0.64 terminals. The proper adapter for 0.64 terminals is the J 35616-64B which has a gold terminal and a black wire between the base and tip. Failure to use the proper test adapter may result in damage to the terminal being tested and improper diagnosis. NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Page 8076 Diagram Information and Instructions Engine Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions Electrical Symbols Page 6218 4. Once the front 2 locks are unlocked, lift the front of the dress cover and pull it forward. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the small slot on the TPA and pushing down until the TPA releases. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to angle or rock the J 38125-21 tool when inserting it into the connector or the tool may break. Insert the J 38125-21 (GM P/N 15381651-2) tool into the round canal between the terminals cavities at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to repair Micro 64 connector terminals. The Micro 64 connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-64 (M jaw) was developed to crimp Micro 64 terminals. The J 38125-64 crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. The J 38125-64 crimping tool is also designed to crimp both the wire and the insulation at the same time. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro 64 terminals. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. 1. Cut the wire as close to the damaged terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. Page 1563 Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Page 6888 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (BSK) BOSCH CONNECTORS (BSK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 3. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 4. Insert the J 38125-561 tool into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 5. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is Page 6192 to analyze the data during the time a vehicle condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a trigger point that you have determined. Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2 snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a first-in, first-out basis. If a third snapshot is taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost. Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types: Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice - Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200 frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not lost if the Scan Tool is powered down. The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis. The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected values by plotting 3 parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful, especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC. Testing for a Short to Voltage TESTING FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4. Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt, there is a short to voltage in the circuit. Testing for Continuity TESTING FOR CONTINUITY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6. Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit. 7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity. With a Test Lamp IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits. 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6. If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity. Testing for Electrical Intermittents TESTING FOR ELECTRICAL INTERMITTENTS Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment. - Testing for Short to Ground - Testing for Continuity - Testing for a Short to Voltage Page 7140 Page 3239 to analyze the data during the time a vehicle condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a trigger point that you have determined. Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2 snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a first-in, first-out basis. If a third snapshot is taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost. Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types: Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice - Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200 frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not lost if the Scan Tool is powered down. The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis. The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected values by plotting 3 parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful, especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC. Testing for a Short to Voltage TESTING FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4. Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt, there is a short to voltage in the circuit. Testing for Continuity TESTING FOR CONTINUITY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6. Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit. 7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity. With a Test Lamp IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits. 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6. If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity. Testing for Electrical Intermittents TESTING FOR ELECTRICAL INTERMITTENTS Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment. - Testing for Short to Ground - Testing for Continuity - Testing for a Short to Voltage Page 3740 - In some cases Delphi will actually be printed on the connector. If Delphi is not printed on the connector, look for PED. In both cases there is no specific orientation for Delphi or PED and they can appear anywhere on the connector. - FCI connectors may have the FCI logo on their connectors. The logo is the letters FCI with an "A" above it. - JAE connector have JAE in small letters on their connectors. Page 1619 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry one side of the nose piece up to the pre-stage position. When the nose piece is in the pre-staged position, the nose piece will be raised above the connector body the length of the step in the nose piece. 7. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry the other side of the piece to the pre-stage position. If the nose piece is higher than the first step in the nose piece, gently push down on the nose piece until it meets with resistance from the connector body, you should feel the nose piece click into position. Page 1515 5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape. Seat Belt Schematic Icons Seat Belt Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons Page 4454 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches, and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original. - The wires insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the possibility of fuel contact. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1). 5. Select the proper duraseal splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool. Refer to the Crimp and Seal Splice Table. 6. Place the duraseal splice sleeve in the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115) crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 7. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to hold the duraseal splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 8. Insert the wires into the duraseal splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel in order to prevent the wire from passing through the splice (3). 9. Close the handles of the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115), until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is applied to the splice sleeve. 10. Shrink the insulation around the splice. - Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. - Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Splicing Inline Harness Diodes SPLICING INLINE HARNESS DIODES Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure. 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode. 2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool. 5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode. Page 13 4. Install the remaining electrical connectors to the VCIM. 5. Install the VCIM (1) to the bracket. 6. Ensure the retaining tab (1) is fully seated. 7. Install the protective cover (1) to the module. 8. Position the right second row seat to a passenger position. Important: After replacing the vehicle communication interface module, you must reconfigure the OnStar(R) system. Failure to reconfigure the system will result in an additional customer visit for repair. In addition, pressing and holding the white dot button on the keypad will NOT reset this version of the OnStar(R) system. This action will cause a DTC to set. 9. Install the scan tool. Use the special functions menu in order to perform the OnStar(R) setup procedure for this vehicle. 10. Move the vehicle to an open area that is away from tall buildings and with a clear view of unobstructed sky. Allow the vehicle to run for 10 minutes. 11. Use the ID information menu on the scan tool to access the new station ID (STID) and the electronic serial number (ESN) from the new VCIM. 12. Press the blue OnStar(R) button to connect to the OnStar(R) Call Center and perform the following procedure: 1. Tell the advisor that this vehicle has received a new VCIM. 2. Ask the advisor to add the new STID and the ESN to update the customer's account. 3. Follow any additional instructions from the OnStar(R) advisor. 4. Ask the advisor to activate the OnStar(R) Personal Calling feature, if available. Page 4128 Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 1. Install the oil filter adapter (1). Tighten the adapter to 55 N.m (40 lb ft). 2. Install the oil filter. Refer to Engine Oil and Oil Filter Replacement. Page 4545 Release the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the blue locking tabs on both ends of the connector. Gently slide the TPA up to the released position on both ends. 6. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-13A (GM P/N 12031876-1) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. Page 559 Wheels/Tires - Refinishing Aluminum Wheels Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels/Tires - Refinishing Aluminum Wheels INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 99-08-51-007E Date: March 17, 2011 Subject: Refinishing Aluminum Wheels Models: 2012 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add additional model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 99-08-51-007D (Section 08 - Body and Accessories). This bulletin updates General Motor's position on refinishing aluminum wheels. GM does not endorse any repairs that involve welding, bending, straightening or re-machining. Only cosmetic refinishing of the wheel's coatings, using recommended procedures, is allowed. Evaluating Damage In evaluating damage, it is the GM Dealer's responsibility to inspect the wheel for corrosion, scrapes, gouges, etc. The Dealer must insure that such damage is not deeper than what can be sanded or polished off. The wheel must be inspected for cracks. If cracks are found, discard the wheel. Any wheels with bent rim flanges must not be repaired or refinished. Wheels that have been refinished by an outside company must be returned to the same vehicle. The Dealer must record the wheel ID stamp or the cast date on the wheel in order to assure this requirement. Refer to Refinisher's Responsibility - Outside Company later in this bulletin. Aluminum Wheel Refinishing Recommendations - Chrome-plated aluminum wheels Re-plating these wheels is not recommended. - Polished aluminum wheels These wheels have a polyester or acrylic clearcoat on them. If the clearcoat is damaged, refinishing is possible. However, the required refinishing process cannot be performed in the dealer environment. Refer to Refinisher's Responsibility - Outside Company later in this bulletin. - Painted aluminum wheels These wheels are painted using a primer, color coat, and clearcoat procedure. If the paint is damaged, refinishing is possible. As with polished wheels, all original coatings must be removed first. Media blasting is recommended. Refer to GM Aluminum Refinishing Bulletin #53-17-03A for the re-painting of this type of wheel. - Bright, machined aluminum wheels These wheels have a polyester or acrylic clearcoat on them. In some cases, the recessed "pocket" areas of the wheel may be painted. Surface refinishing is possible. The wheel must be totally stripped by media blasting or other suitable means. The wheel should be resurfaced by using a sanding process rather than a machining process. This allows the least amount of material to be removed. Important Do not use any re-machining process that removes aluminum. This could affect the dimensions and function of the wheel. Painting is an option to re-clearcoating polished and bright machined aluminum wheels. Paint will better mask any surface imperfections and is somewhat more durable than clearcoat alone. GM recommends using Corsican SILVER WAEQ9283 for a fine "aluminum-like" look or Sparkle SILVER WA9967 for a very bright look. As an option, the body color may also be used. When using any of the painting options, it is recommended that all four wheels be refinished in order to maintain color uniformity. Refer to GM Aluminum Refinishing Bulletin #53-17-03A for specific procedures and product recommendations. Refinisher's Responsibility - Outside Company Important Some outside companies are offering wheel refinishing services. Such refinished wheels will be permanently marked by the refinisher and are warranted by the refinisher. Any process that re-machines or otherwise re-manufactures the wheel should not be used. A refinisher's responsibility includes inspecting for cracks using the Zyglo system or the equivalent. Any cracked wheels must not be refinished. No welding, hammering or reforming of any kind is allowed. The wheel ID must be recorded and follow the wheel throughout the process in order to assure that the same wheel is returned. A plastic media blast may be used for clean up of the wheel. Hand and/or lathe sanding of the machined surface and the wheel window is allowed. Material removal, though, must be kept to a minimum. Re-machining of the wheel is not allowed. Paint and/or clear coat must not be present on the following surfaces: the nut chamfers, the wheel mounting surfaces and the wheel pilot hole. The refinisher must permanently ID stamp the wheel and warrant the painted/clearcoated surfaces for a minimum of one year or the remainder of the new vehicle warranty, whichever is Page 4672 11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the solder equipment. 12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. 13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to cover the first piece of tape. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE SLEEVES TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit IMPORTANT: Use only dura seal splice sleeves. Other splice sleeves may not protect the splice from moisture or provide a good electrical connection. Use duraseal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. Use duraseal splice sleeves where there is special requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire using duraseal splice sleeves. Page 7860 Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Heated Oxygen Sensor Replacement - Bank 2 Sensor 2 Heated Oxygen Sensor Replacement - Bank 2 Sensor 2 Removal Procedure 1. Raise and suitably support the vehicle. Refer to vehicle lifting. Notice: Refer to Heated Oxygen and Oxygen Sensor Notice. 2. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) retainer. 3. Disconnect the heated oxygen sensor (HO2S) electrical connector (1). Notice: Refer to Excessive Force and Oxygen Sensor Notice. 4. Remove the HO2S (2). Installation Procedure Important: A special anti-seize compound is used on the HO2S threads. The compound consists of liquid graphite and glass beads. The graphite tends to burn away, but the glass beads remain, making the sensor easier to remove. New, or service replacement sensors already have the compound applied to the threads. If the sensor is removed from an exhaust component and if for any reason the sensor is to be reinstalled, the threads must have anti-seize compound applied before the reinstallation. Page 3466 Page 7043 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert terminal into the appropriate terminal holder until it hits bottom and stops. The correct terminal holder is determined by the wire size. Also ensure that the terminals wings are pointing towards the former on the tool and the release locator. 5. Insert the stripped cable into the terminal. Insulation should be visible on both sides of the terminal insulation wings. 6. Compress the handles until the ratchet automatically releases. 7. Place the terminal into the appropriate cavity and assemble the connector. Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO-PACK 100W) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W connectors. These connectors are very similar but use different terminals and have some minor physical differences also. Multifunction Turn Signal Switch Housing Replacement Turn Signal Switch: Service and Repair Multifunction Turn Signal Switch Housing Replacement Multifunction Turn Signal Switch Housing Replacement Removal Procedure Caution: Refer to SIR Caution in Cautions and Notices. 1. Disable the SIR system. Refer to SIR Disabling and Enabling. 2. Remove the steering wheel from the column. Refer to Steering Wheel Replacement. 3. Remove the ignition lock cylinder case assembly. Refer to Ignition Lock Cylinder Case Replacement. 4. Remove the turn signal and multifunction switch assembly. Refer to Turn Signal Multifunction Switch Replacement. 5. Slide the turn signal switch housing off of the steering column shaft assembly. Installation Procedure Page 8385 Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. For connectors with a bolt in the dress cover, turn the bolt counterclockwise to remove the connector from the component. 2. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. Page 7652 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully raise the TPA on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA cannot be removed from the connector while there are terminals present in the connector body. View of the TPA when removed from the connector body. 4. Use the J 38125-12A tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the left side of the terminal release cavity as shown in the graphic. Use the tool to move the terminal release to the right with a gentle prying motion. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 5305 IMPORTANT: Ensure that the dress cover and connector body are both in the released position before reassembling. Failure to do so may cause damage to the connector and component. Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (0.64) BOSCH CONNECTORS (0.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While pressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock until the lever is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Pull the rubber boot that covers the wires back to expose the end of the connector dress cover. 4. Place the connector locking lever in the center of the connector. 5. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs that are on the wire end of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover and connector body and pry up. Page 3056 7. Disconnect the power steering pressure (1) and return hose (3) from the power steering pump (2). 8. Remove the engine control module (ECM) from the ECM mounting bracket and position the ECM out of the way. Refer to Engine Control Module Replacement. 9. Remove the power steering hose assembly (1) front bracket mounting bolt (3) from the frame. 10. Remove the power steering pressure hose from the retaining clip. 11. Remove the power steering hose assembly rear bracket mounting bolt (2). 12. Remove the power steering hose assembly from the vehicle. 13. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. Notice: Clean the power steering gear inlet and outlet ports thoroughly of any debris. Failure to do so could result in contamination and damage to the power steering system components. 14. Install the seal extraction end of the J 44586 (2) to the power steering gear oil seal (1). Page 6807 4. Install the ground, then the washer and then the bolt to the frame. Important: It is important to use the bolts, washers and nuts specified in this bulletin. These parts have been identified due to their conductive finish. 5. Install a washer and nut to the back side of the frame. Tighten Tighten the nut to 9 Nm (79 lb in). 6. Cover the front and back side of the repair area using Rubberized Undercoating. An additional check can be made to ensure a good connection for the battery cable to frame ground. It is possible for this ground to cause similar symptoms with the ABS as described above. *We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may be available from other sources. Parts Information Warranty Information Disclaimer Page 5319 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert terminal into the appropriate terminal holder until it hits bottom and stops. The correct terminal holder is determined by the wire size. Also ensure that the terminals wings are pointing towards the former on the tool and the release locator. 5. Insert the stripped cable into the terminal. Insulation should be visible on both sides of the terminal insulation wings. 6. Compress the handles until the ratchet automatically releases. 7. Place the terminal into the appropriate cavity and assemble the connector. Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO-PACK 100W) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W connectors. These connectors are very similar but use different terminals and have some minor physical differences also. Page 1983 IMPORTANT: Ensure that the dress cover and connector body are both in the released position before reassembling. Failure to do so may cause damage to the connector and component. Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (0.64) BOSCH CONNECTORS (0.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While pressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock until the lever is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Pull the rubber boot that covers the wires back to expose the end of the connector dress cover. 4. Place the connector locking lever in the center of the connector. 5. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs that are on the wire end of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover and connector body and pry up. Page 5407 Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids Arrows and Symbols Arrows and Symbols This Service Data uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations. Arrows and Symbols 1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow Basic Knowledge Required GENERAL ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures contained in the service manual. You should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current (amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram, as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. Decimal and Metric Equivalents Decimal and Metric Equivalents Page 1723 - Kostel - Molex - Sumitomo - Tyco/AMP - Yazaki Identifying the manufacturer of a connector is often difficult. When trying to determine the manufacturer of a connector, look for specific identifying marks that are unique to that connector supplier. Most of these identify marks are hard to find or see. Check the connector carefully and refer to the information below for pictures and descriptions of connector identification markings. - Most of AFLs connectors have EPC on their connector body. Some of the smaller connectors will not have any markings on them. - In some cases Bosch will actually be printed on the connector. If Bosch does not appear on the connector, look for the Bosch logo. The Bosch logo is a circle with a blunted arrow inside. This logo can appear anywhere on the connector and is often very small. Page 1623 5. Once the nose piece retainers are relaxed, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should raise slightly. 6. On the opposite side of the nose piece, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should release completely. If the nose piece does not come off, repeat the procedure on the opposite side. Page 4870 Page 6091 - Yazaki has a wedge or arrow shape, similar to that shown. Delphi Connectors (Micro .64) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro 64 connectors. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. The lever lock may be located on the top or sides of the wire dress cover. Page 5487 Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size. REPAIRING A FUSIBLE LINK IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient overload protection. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. Flat Wire Repairs FLAT WIRE REPAIRS NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced. GMLAN Wiring Repairs GMLAN WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The GM Local Area Network (GMLAN) System requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working on GMLAN connectors and terminals. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items in order to repair the GMLAN wiring: Dura Seal splice sleeves - A wire stripping tool - J 38125-8 Crimping Tool (GM P/N 12085115) - J 38125-5 Ultra Torch Special Tool (GM P/N 12085116) The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. - A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors GMLAN REPAIRS IMPORTANT: When making a repair to any GMLAN network, the original wire length after the repair must be the same length as before the repair. If the network is a twisted pair, the twist must be maintained after the repair is completed. GMLAN has 2 types of networks, low speed and high speed. Low speed GMLAN has a single wire and works at slow speeds. High speed GMLAN has 2 wires in a twisted pair and works at higher speeds. For more information on GMLAN, refer to Data Link Communications Description and Operation. GMLAN CONNECTOR TERMINAL REPAIR IMPORTANT: A service terminal can be used to replace damaged connector terminals for both high speed and low speed GMLAN systems. When making a connector terminal repair on a GMLAN high speed system with twisted pair wires, do not untwist the wires more than necessary to make the repair. The terminals in the GMLAN system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are available in the J-38125. If the individual terminals are damaged on any GMLAN connection, use the appropriate connector repair procedure in order to repair the terminal. GMLAN WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 6719 3. Use a small flat-bladed tool to gently pry off the dress cover by inserting the tool under the cover opposite the harness side and prying up. 4. Remove the cover. 5. Using a small flat-bladed tool, push on the side of the nose piece retainer while pushing the nose piece forward with your thumb. This will release the terminal position assurance (TPA). 6. Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) into the corresponding terminal release cavity. The release cavities are the 2 center rows of cavities on one half of the connector. Page 4492 5. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove TPA from the connector. 6. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Page 7432 Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Engine Control Module Replacement Service of the engine control module (ECM) should consist of either replacement of the ECM or programming of the electrically erasable programmable read only memory (EEPROM). If the diagnostic procedures call for the ECM to be replaced, the replacement ECM should be checked to ensure that the correct part is being used. If the correct part is being used, remove the faulty ECM and install the new service ECM. The replacement ECM must be programmed. Notice: * Turn the ignition OFF when installing or removing the control module connectors and disconnecting or reconnecting the power to the control module (battery cable, powertrain control module (PCM)/engine control module (ECM)/transaxle control module (TCM) pigtail, control module fuse, jumper cables, etc.) in order to prevent internal control module damage. * Control module damage may result when the metal case contacts battery voltage. DO NOT contact the control module metal case with battery voltage when servicing a control module, using battery booster cables, or when charging the vehicle battery. * In order to prevent any possible electrostatic discharge damage to the control module, do no touch the connector pins or the soldered components on the circuit board. * Remove any debris from around the control module connector surfaces before servicing the control module. Inspect the control module connector gaskets when diagnosing or replacing the control module. Ensure that the gaskets are installed correctly. The gaskets prevent contaminant intrusion into the control module. * The replacement control module must be programmed. Important: It is necessary to record the remaining engine oil life. If the replacement module is not programed with the remaining engine oil life, the engine oil life will default to 100 percent. If the replacement module is not programmed with the remaining engine oil life, the engine oil will need to be changed at 5 000 km (3,000 mi) from the last engine oil change. Removal Procedure 1. Using a scan tool, retrieve the percentage of remaining engine oil. Record the remaining engine oil life. 2. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 3. Disconnect the cooling fan electrical connector for additional clearance while removing the ECM. 4. Squeeze the ECM/transmission control module (TCM) cover upper retainers (1) in. 5. Remove the ECM/TCM cover. Page 3300 6. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by pressing on the tang. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (SENSOR) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) tool into the cavity on the lower right hand face of the connector until the terminal release tang access panel slides over. Page 7680 breakers are used. CIRCUIT BREAKER This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high current is removed. POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) CIRCUIT BREAKER This type greatly increases its resistance when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker will re-close within a second or 2. Circuit Protection - Fuses CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSES The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and examine the element in the fuse for an open (2). If not broken (1), also check for continuity using a DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one of equal current rating. Circuit Protection - Fusible Links CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSIBLE LINKS Page 5632 Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under the 5 year / 100,000 mile (160,000 km) emission warranty, use: Warranty Information (Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 1920 Open the harness by removing any tape. 2. Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. 3. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 4. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent american wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 5. Slide a section of high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing down the length of wire to be spliced. Ensure that the shrink tubing will not interfere with the splice procedure. 6. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 7. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. 8. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 9. Insert the wire into the DuraSeal splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 10. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Page 3558 Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Sensor Replacement Tire Pressure Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Raise the vehicle on a suitable support. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 2. Remove the tire/wheel assembly from the vehicle. Refer to Tire and Wheel Removal and Installation. Important: Before the tire is removed from the wheel, note the following items to avoid tire pressure sensor damage upon tire dismounting. ^ Place the sensors cap and valve on a dry clean surface after removal. The cap is aluminum and the valve is nickel plated to prevent corrosion and are not to be substituted with a cap or valve made of any other material. ^ When separating the tire bead from the wheel, position the bead breaking fixture 90 degrees from the valve stem. ^ Position the mounting/dismounting head so the tire iron, or pry bar can be inserted slightly clockwise of the sensor body when prying the tire bead up and over the mounting/dismounting head. ^ Using the tire machine, rotate the tire/wheel assembly clockwise when transferring the tire bead to the outside of the wheel rim. ^ Repeat items for inner bead. Remove the tire from the wheel. Refer to Tire Mounting and Dismounting. Important: If any tire sealant is noted upon tire dismounting, remove all residual liquid sealant from the inside of the tire and wheel surfaces. 3. Remove the tire pressure sensor nut. 4. Remove the tire pressure sensor. Installation Procedure 1. Clean any dirt or debris from the grommet sealing area. 2. Insert the sensor in the wheel hole with the air passage facing away from the wheel. Page 8314 If a wire is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm, etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except coaxial. - Do not use the DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent American wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 2379 3. Ensure that the terminal release tang access panel is in the correct location to access the terminals. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) into the terminal release tang access slot located behind the access panel of the connector and press down on the terminal while carefully pulling the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Tyco/AMP Connectors (0.25 Cap) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (025 CAP) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component by pressing down on the connector position assurance (CPA). Page 4401 7. Apply pressure and gently rock the cover until one locking leg is unseated. 8. Continue to apply pressure and rock the cover until the second locking leg is unseated. Repeat procedure for the other side of the dress cover and remove the cover. 9. Use J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) to gently lift the terminal retaining tab while gently pulling the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 10. If the terminal is severely bent or damaged, it may be possible on some connectors to push the wire out of the front of the connector instead of Page 5496 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link). - The wire insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. 5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold them between thumb and forefinger. 7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place. - Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction. - Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip. 8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool closes.Ensure that no strands of wire are cut. 10. Crimp the splice on each end (2). Page 2845 Alignment: Specifications Wheel Alignment Specifications Wheel Alignment Specifications Wheel Alignment Specifications Page 5231 The engine harness may be repaired using the J-38125. High Temperature Wiring Repairs HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperatures, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time may use materials i.e. wires, connectors, and shielding that has a higher heat rating than typical wiring. When making a repair in a high temperature area observe the following: Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature to replace any damaged wire. - Replace any heat shielding that is removed. - Cover any DuraSeal splice sleeves with SCT1 shrink tubing (available in the J-38125 Terminal Repair kit). - After making a wiring repair, ensure that the location of the wiring is not moved closer to the heat source. IDENTIFYING HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperature, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time need special considerations when making wiring repairs. Areas that may be exposed to higher temperatures can be identified by heat resistant materials that are being used in those areas. These materials may include heat reflective tape, moon tape, and high temperature shrink tubing. Also conduit and other protective coverings may be used. Because conduit or similar coverings are used throughout the vehicle regardless of the temperature, it may be necessary for the technician to determine if an area is exposed to excessive heat before making a wiring repair. Obvious areas of consideration would be any area located near the exhaust manifolds, catalytic converter, and exhaust pipes. The J-38125 contains much of the material you will need to perform repairs on areas exposed to high heat. The kit contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves to crimp and seal connections - High temperature SCT1 shrink tubing to protect the splice sleeves - A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct crimp tool to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools to remove the terminals from the connectors The J-38125 does not contain wire that is suitable to high temperature exposure. Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature of the same or larger gage size as the original wire when repair damage wire. Also replace any reflective tape that you remove during the repair. HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature rating of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125 and then encapsulate the splice sleeve using the high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the order listed. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip keeping all of the wire strands intact. Drive Belt Chirping, Squeal, and Whine Diagnosis Drive Belt: Testing and Inspection Drive Belt Chirping, Squeal, and Whine Diagnosis Drive Belt Chirping, Squeal, and Whine Diagnosis Diagnostic Aids ^ A chirping or squeal noise may be intermittent due to moisture on the drive belts or the pulleys. It may be necessary to spray a small amount of water on the drive belts in order to duplicate the customers concern. If spraying water on the drive belt duplicates the symptom, cleaning the belt pulleys may be the probable solution. ^ If the noise is intermittent, verify the accessory drive components by varying their loads making sure they are operated to their maximum capacity. An overcharged A/C system, power steering system with a pinched hose or wrong fluid, or a generator failing are suggested items to inspect. ^ A chirping, squeal or whine noise may be caused by a loose or improper installation of a body or suspension component. Other items of the vehicle may also cause the noise. ^ The drive belts will not cause a whine noise. Test Description The numbers below refer to the step numbers on the diagnostic table. 2. The noise may not be engine related. This step is to verify that the engine is making the noise. If the engine is not making the noise do not proceed further with this table. 3. The noise may be an internal engine noise. Removing the drive belts one at a time and operating the engine for a brief period will verify the noise is related to the drive belt. When removing the drive belt the water pump may not be operating and the engine may overheat. Also DTCs may set when the engine is operating with the drive belts removed. 4. Inspect all drive belt pulleys for pilling. Pilling is the small balls or pills or it can be strings in the drive belt grooves from the accumulation of rubber dust. 6. Misalignment of the pulleys may be caused from improper mounting of the accessory drive component, incorrect installation of the accessory drive component pulley, or the pulley bent inward or outward from a previous repair. Test for a misaligned pulley using a straight edge in the pulley grooves across 2 or 3 pulleys. If a misaligned pulley is found refer to that accessory drive component for the proper installation procedure for that pulley. 10. Inspecting of the fasteners can eliminate the possibility that a wrong bolt, nut, spacer, or washer was installed. 12. Inspecting the pulleys for being bent should include inspecting for a dent or other damage to the pulleys that would prevent the drive belt from not seating properly in all of the pulley grooves or on the smooth surface of a pulley when the back side of the belt is used to drive the pulley. 14. This test is to verify that the drive belt tensioner operates properly. If the drive belt tensioner is not operating properly, proper belt tension may not be achieved to keep the drive belt from slipping which could cause a squeal noise. 15. This test is to verify that the drive belt is not too long, which would prevent the drive belt tensioner from working properly. Also if an incorrect length drive belt was installed, it may not be routed properly and may be turning an accessory drive component in the wrong direction. 16. Misalignment of the pulleys may be caused from improper mounting of the accessory drive component, incorrect installation of the accessory drive component pulley, or the pulley bent inward or outward from a previous repair. Test for a misaligned pulley using a straight edge in the pulley grooves across 2 or 3 pulleys. If a misaligned pulley is found refer to that accessory drive component for the proper installation procedure for that pulley. 17. This test is to verify that the pulleys are the correct diameter or width. Using a known good vehicle compare the pulley sizes. 19. Replacing the drive belt when it is not damaged or there is not excessive pilling will only be a temporary repair. Page 1850 3. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. View showing depressing of the lever lock release tab. Page 4864 11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the solder equipment. 12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. 13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to cover the first piece of tape. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE SLEEVES TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit IMPORTANT: Use only dura seal splice sleeves. Other splice sleeves may not protect the splice from moisture or provide a good electrical connection. Use duraseal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. Use duraseal splice sleeves where there is special requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire using duraseal splice sleeves. Page 6738 Open the harness by removing any tape. 2. Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. 3. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 4. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent american wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 5. Slide a section of high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing down the length of wire to be spliced. Ensure that the shrink tubing will not interfere with the splice procedure. 6. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 7. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. 8. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 9. Insert the wire into the DuraSeal splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 10. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Page 4972 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the DuraSeal splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of a connector. CPAs are used in all SIR System connectors and also in some connectors of other systems. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals of a connection. TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE CLIPS IMPORTANT: When making a splice in an area that may be exposed to moisture use a crimp and seal splice sleeve instead of a Splice Clip. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. Page 7393 6. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by pressing on the tang. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (SENSOR) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) tool into the cavity on the lower right hand face of the connector until the terminal release tang access panel slides over. Page 2743 1. Position the steering wheel sensor (3) to the steering column. 2. Position the steering wheel sensor retainer plate (2) to the steering column. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 3. Install the steering wheel position sensor retainer screws (1). Tighten the screws to 10 N.m (89 lb in). 4. Remove the steering wheel position sensor anti-rotation pin from the sensor. 5. Connect the electrical connector to the steering wheel position sensor. 6. Install the intermediate shaft to the steering column. Refer to Upper Intermediate Steering Shaft Replacement. 7. Enable the SIR system. Refer to SIR Disabling and Enabling. Page 546 The engine harness may be repaired using the J-38125. High Temperature Wiring Repairs HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperatures, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time may use materials i.e. wires, connectors, and shielding that has a higher heat rating than typical wiring. When making a repair in a high temperature area observe the following: Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature to replace any damaged wire. - Replace any heat shielding that is removed. - Cover any DuraSeal splice sleeves with SCT1 shrink tubing (available in the J-38125 Terminal Repair kit). - After making a wiring repair, ensure that the location of the wiring is not moved closer to the heat source. IDENTIFYING HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperature, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time need special considerations when making wiring repairs. Areas that may be exposed to higher temperatures can be identified by heat resistant materials that are being used in those areas. These materials may include heat reflective tape, moon tape, and high temperature shrink tubing. Also conduit and other protective coverings may be used. Because conduit or similar coverings are used throughout the vehicle regardless of the temperature, it may be necessary for the technician to determine if an area is exposed to excessive heat before making a wiring repair. Obvious areas of consideration would be any area located near the exhaust manifolds, catalytic converter, and exhaust pipes. The J-38125 contains much of the material you will need to perform repairs on areas exposed to high heat. The kit contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves to crimp and seal connections - High temperature SCT1 shrink tubing to protect the splice sleeves - A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct crimp tool to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools to remove the terminals from the connectors The J-38125 does not contain wire that is suitable to high temperature exposure. Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature of the same or larger gage size as the original wire when repair damage wire. Also replace any reflective tape that you remove during the repair. HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature rating of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125 and then encapsulate the splice sleeve using the high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the order listed. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip keeping all of the wire strands intact. Page 6902 View of a typical Micro 64 connector. Depress the lock and pull the lever over and past the lock. Page 4516 Release the lower wiredress cover locking tab. Release the upper wiredress cover locking tab. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. Page 4433 3. Ensure that the terminal release tang access panel is in the correct location to access the terminals. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) into the terminal release tang access slot located behind the access panel of the connector and press down on the terminal while carefully pulling the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Tyco/AMP Connectors (0.25 Cap) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (025 CAP) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component by pressing down on the connector position assurance (CPA). Page 7202 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the rear TPA from the connector. 7. IMPORTANT: The front TPA cannot be removed from the connector. Only move it to the release point. Use a small flat-blade tool to move the front TPA to the release position. 8. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 9. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Molex Connectors Page 8383 - A control module from another vehicle is installed. - Revised software/calibration files have been released for this vehicle. - IMPORTANT: DO NOT re-program the control module with the SAME software/calibration files that are already present in the control module. This is not an effective repair for any type of concern. Verify that the control module contains the correct software/calibration. If incorrect programming is found, reprogram the control module with the most current software/calibration. Refer to Control Module References for replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Testing for Short to Ground TESTING FOR SHORT TO GROUND NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 4. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit. With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is a short to ground in the circuit. Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2. Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). - When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. - If the DMM does not display voltage 4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is shorted. Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A DIGITAL MULTIMETER NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the powertrain control module (PCM), should only be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200 Digital Multimeter (DMM). The J 39200 instruction manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminage even though voltage is present. The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity. IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading. Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the measurement. Page 7403 breakers are used. CIRCUIT BREAKER This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high current is removed. POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) CIRCUIT BREAKER This type greatly increases its resistance when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker will re-close within a second or 2. Circuit Protection - Fuses CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSES The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and examine the element in the fuse for an open (2). If not broken (1), also check for continuity using a DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one of equal current rating. Circuit Protection - Fusible Links CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSIBLE LINKS Page 6162 Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair Park/Neutral Position Switch Replacement Tools Required J 41364-A Park/Neutral Switch Aligner Removal Procedure 1. Apply the parking brake. 2. Shift the transmission into neutral. 3. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 4. Remove the nut securing the transmission control lever to the manual shaft. 5. Remove the transmission control lever from the manual shaft. 6. Disconnect the electrical connectors from the switch. 7. Remove the bolts securing the park/neutral position switch to the transmission. 8. Remove the park/neutral position switch from the manual shaft. If the park/neutral position switch did not slide off the manual shaft, file the outer edge of the manual shaft in order to remove any burrs. Installation Procedure 1. Install the switch to the transmission manual shaft by aligning the switch hub flats with the manual shaft flats. 2. Slide the switch onto the transmission manual shaft until the switch mounting bracket contacts the mounting bosses on the transmission. Important: If a new switch is being installed, the switch will come with a positive assurance bracket. The positive assurance bracket aligns the new switch in it proper position for installation and the use of neutral position adjustment tool will not be necessary. 3. Install the switch to the transmission with 2 bolts finger tight. Page 5448 TERMINAL REMOVAL Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors. 1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA) device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1). 3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 4. Gently pull the cable and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector. 5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal, refer to Terminal Repair. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3. Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector. REINSTALLING TERMINAL 1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly, refer to Wiring Repairs. 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3. Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) DELPHI CONNECTORS (WEATHER PACK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 1478 MOLEX CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. 2. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. Page 2491 6. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by pressing on the tang. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (SENSOR) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) tool into the cavity on the lower right hand face of the connector until the terminal release tang access panel slides over. Page 1788 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches, and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original. - The wires insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the possibility of fuel contact. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1). 5. Select the proper duraseal splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool. Refer to the Crimp and Seal Splice Table. 6. Place the duraseal splice sleeve in the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115) crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 7. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to hold the duraseal splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 8. Insert the wires into the duraseal splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel in order to prevent the wire from passing through the splice (3). 9. Close the handles of the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115), until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is applied to the splice sleeve. 10. Shrink the insulation around the splice. - Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. - Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Splicing Inline Harness Diodes SPLICING INLINE HARNESS DIODES Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure. 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode. 2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool. 5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode. Page 3021 Installation Procedure 1. Wipe the excess oil from the oil filter mounting. 2. Lubricate the oil filter seal with clean engine oil. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 3. Install the oil filter to the oil pan. Tighten the filter to 30 N.m (22 lb ft). 4. Wipe the excess oil from the drain plug hole. 5. Install the oil drain plug to the oil pan. Tighten the oil pan drain plug to 25 N.m (18 lb ft). Page 351 Utility/Van Zoning UTILITY/VAN ZONING Locations Fog/Driving Lamp Relay: Locations Fuse Block - Underhood (5.3L/6.0L), Label Page 1454 View of the connector when released from the component. View of another type of Micro 64 connector. Page 3065 6. Heater outlet hose to engine (6). 7. Heater inlet hose to front of dash (7). 8. Heater outlet hose to front of dash (8). Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models) Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models) Page 4546 View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. View of the release tool being used for the smaller terminals. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (2-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 8645 Utility/Van Zoning UTILITY/VAN ZONING Specifications Water Pump: Specifications Important: All gasket surfaces are to be free of oil or other foreign material during assembly. Install the water pump and NEW gaskets. Install the water pump bolts. On the initial pass, tighten the bolts to ................................................................................................................................................... 15 N.m (11 lb ft). On the final pass, tighten the bolts to ..................................................................................................................................................... 30 N.m (22 lb ft). Lumbar Adjuster Switch Power Seat Switch: Diagrams Lumbar Adjuster Switch Lumbar Adjuster Switch - Driver (With RPO Code AR9) Page 7653 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Kostal Connectors KOSTAL CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 1240 Turn Signal/Multifunction Switch C3 Page 831 difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Bosch Connectors (ECM) BOSCH CONNECTORS (ECM) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the assist lever on the top of the connector. Move the assist lever to the forward position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 6043 Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Heated Oxygen Sensor Replacement - Bank 1 Sensor 2 Heated Oxygen Sensor Replacement - Bank 1 Sensor 2 Removal Procedure 1. Raise and suitably support the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. Notice: Refer to Heated Oxygen and Oxygen Sensor Notice. 2. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) retainer. 3. Disconnect the heated oxygen sensor (HO2S) electrical connector. Notice: Refer to Excessive Force and Oxygen Sensor Notice. 4. Remove the HO2S (2). Installation Procedure Important: A special anti-seize compound is used on the HO2S threads. The compound consists of liquid graphite and glass beads. The graphite tends to burn away, but the glass beads remain, making the sensor easier to remove. New, or service replacement sensors already have the compound applied to the threads. If the sensor is removed from an exhaust component and if for any reason the sensor is to be reinstalled, the threads must have anti-seize compound applied before the reinstallation. Page 2389 Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size. REPAIRING A FUSIBLE LINK IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient overload protection. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. Flat Wire Repairs FLAT WIRE REPAIRS NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced. GMLAN Wiring Repairs GMLAN WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The GM Local Area Network (GMLAN) System requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working on GMLAN connectors and terminals. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items in order to repair the GMLAN wiring: Dura Seal splice sleeves - A wire stripping tool - J 38125-8 Crimping Tool (GM P/N 12085115) - J 38125-5 Ultra Torch Special Tool (GM P/N 12085116) The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. - A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors GMLAN REPAIRS IMPORTANT: When making a repair to any GMLAN network, the original wire length after the repair must be the same length as before the repair. If the network is a twisted pair, the twist must be maintained after the repair is completed. GMLAN has 2 types of networks, low speed and high speed. Low speed GMLAN has a single wire and works at slow speeds. High speed GMLAN has 2 wires in a twisted pair and works at higher speeds. For more information on GMLAN, refer to Data Link Communications Description and Operation. GMLAN CONNECTOR TERMINAL REPAIR IMPORTANT: A service terminal can be used to replace damaged connector terminals for both high speed and low speed GMLAN systems. When making a connector terminal repair on a GMLAN high speed system with twisted pair wires, do not untwist the wires more than necessary to make the repair. The terminals in the GMLAN system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are available in the J-38125. If the individual terminals are damaged on any GMLAN connection, use the appropriate connector repair procedure in order to repair the terminal. GMLAN WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 7832 Open the harness by removing any tape. 2. Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. 3. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 4. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent american wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 5. Slide a section of high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing down the length of wire to be spliced. Ensure that the shrink tubing will not interfere with the splice procedure. 6. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 7. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. 8. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 9. Insert the wire into the DuraSeal splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 10. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Page 1690 Page 6046 1. Connect the HO2S electrical connector (2). 2. Install the CPA retainer. Important: A special anti-seize compound is used on the HO2S threads. The compound consists of liquid graphite and glass beads. The graphite tends to burn away, but the glass beads remain, making the sensor easier to remove. New, or service replacement sensors already have the compound applied to the threads. If the sensor is removed from an exhaust component and if for any reason the sensor is to be reinstalled, the threads must have anti-seize compound applied before the reinstallation. 3. If reinstalling the old sensor, coat the threads with anti-seize compound GM P/N 12377953, or equivalent. Notice: Refer to Component Fastener Tightening Notice. Important: If the HO2S sensor is connected to the main wiring harness during installation. Rotate the HO2S sensor several turns counterclockwise before threading the HO2S sensor into the catalytic converter. This action of initially reverse winding of the pigtail wires will prevent a condition where the HO2S sensor pigtail wires become severely twisted or binding once the HO2S sensor is installed into the catalytic converter. 4. Install the HO2S (2). Tighten the sensor to 42 N.m (31 lb ft). 5. Lower the vehicle. Page 1555 Page 2516 US English/Metric Conversion US English/Metric Conversion Page 8572 9. The illustration shows a cutaway view of the connector to aid the technician in releasing the terminal retainer. 10. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Terminal Position Assurance Locks TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Tyco/Amp Connectors (CM 42-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (CM 42-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the connector body and pull the CPA out. The CPA is on the wire harness side of connector. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 5751 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches, and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original. - The wires insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the possibility of fuel contact. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1). 5. Select the proper duraseal splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool. Refer to the Crimp and Seal Splice Table. 6. Place the duraseal splice sleeve in the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115) crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 7. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to hold the duraseal splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 8. Insert the wires into the duraseal splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel in order to prevent the wire from passing through the splice (3). 9. Close the handles of the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115), until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is applied to the splice sleeve. 10. Shrink the insulation around the splice. - Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. - Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Splicing Inline Harness Diodes SPLICING INLINE HARNESS DIODES Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure. 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode. 2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool. 5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode. Page 3426 View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. 4. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers CIRCUIT PROTECTION - CIRCUIT BREAKERS A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types of circuit Page 1776 breakers are used. CIRCUIT BREAKER This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high current is removed. POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) CIRCUIT BREAKER This type greatly increases its resistance when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker will re-close within a second or 2. Circuit Protection - Fuses CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSES The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and examine the element in the fuse for an open (2). If not broken (1), also check for continuity using a DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one of equal current rating. Circuit Protection - Fusible Links CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSIBLE LINKS Page 6371 View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. View of the release tool being used for the smaller terminals. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (2-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 2497 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert a small flat-blade tool in the slot below the front loaded terminal position assurance (TPA) and pry up. 3. Remove the TPA by pulling it out of the connector. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-553 (GM P/N 15315247) on a slight upward angle into the cavity below the terminal to be removed. Ensure that the pointed on the end of the tool is facing the bottom of the terminal and it stays in contact with the terminal until it stops on the plastic terminal retainer. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Service and Repair Fan Clutch: Service and Repair Fan Clutch Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Remove the cooling fan and shroud. Refer to Cooling Fan and Shroud Replacement. 2. Remove the push-pin and release the fan clutch electrical connector from the fan shroud. 3. Remove the fan clutch from the fan shroud. 4. Remove the bolts retaining the fan blade to the fan clutch. 5. Separate the fan blade from the fan clutch. Installation Procedure 1. Assemble the fan blade to the fan clutch. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Install the 4 bolts to the fan blade. Tighten the bolts to 27 N.m (20 lb ft). 3. Install the fan clutch to the fan shroud. 4. Install the push-pin to the fan clutch electrical connector. 5. Install the cooling fan and shroud. Refer to Cooling Fan and Shroud Replacement. Page 8787 3. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. View showing depressing of the lever lock release tab. Page 7072 9. The illustration shows a cutaway view of the connector to aid the technician in releasing the terminal retainer. 10. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Terminal Position Assurance Locks TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Tyco/Amp Connectors (CM 42-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (CM 42-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the connector body and pull the CPA out. The CPA is on the wire harness side of connector. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 4774 Radiator Cooling Fan Control Module: Diagnostic Aids Arrows and Symbols Arrows and Symbols This Service Data uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations. Arrows and Symbols 1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow Basic Knowledge Required GENERAL ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures contained in the service manual. You should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current (amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram, as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. Decimal and Metric Equivalents Decimal and Metric Equivalents Page 377 5. Insert the J 38125-557 (GM P/N 12122378) into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 6. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Connector Position Assurance Locks CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of the connector. CPAs are used in various connectors throughout the vehicle. CPAs are also used in all SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals, of the connector. Connector Repairs CONNECTOR REPAIRS Page 5278 Page 8393 IMPORTANT: Ensure that the dress cover and connector body are both in the released position before reassembling. Failure to do so may cause damage to the connector and component. Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (0.64) BOSCH CONNECTORS (0.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While pressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock until the lever is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Pull the rubber boot that covers the wires back to expose the end of the connector dress cover. 4. Place the connector locking lever in the center of the connector. 5. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs that are on the wire end of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover and connector body and pry up. Page 3716 Checking Aftermarket Accessories CHECKING AFTERMARKET ACCESSORIES Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits: - CAUTION: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol. - NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice. OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol. Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the cause of the problems. Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include: Power feeds connected to points other than the battery - Antenna location - Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring - Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line - Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories. Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions INDUCING INTERMITTENT FAULT CONDITIONS TOOLS REQUIRED J 25070 Heat Gun Many intermittent open or shorted circuits are affected by harness/connector movement that is caused by vibration, engine torque, bumps/rough pavement, etc. In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness if the malfunction appears to be Page 2312 Checking Aftermarket Accessories CHECKING AFTERMARKET ACCESSORIES Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits: - CAUTION: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol. - NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice. OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol. Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the cause of the problems. Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include: Power feeds connected to points other than the battery - Antenna location - Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring - Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line - Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories. Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions INDUCING INTERMITTENT FAULT CONDITIONS TOOLS REQUIRED J 25070 Heat Gun Many intermittent open or shorted circuits are affected by harness/connector movement that is caused by vibration, engine torque, bumps/rough pavement, etc. In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness if the malfunction appears to be Page 5808 Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested: - Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. - Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a component or to other harnesses. - If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A TEST LAMP TOOLS REQUIRED J 35616-200 Test Light - Probe Kit NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminate even though voltage is present. The J 35616-200 is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair of leads. To properly operate this tool use the following procedures. When testing for voltage: 1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested. When testing for ground: 1. Attach one lead to battery positive voltage. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where ground should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is ground at the point being tested. Using Connector Test Adapters USING CONNECTOR TEST ADAPTERS NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Using Fused Jumper Wires USING FUSED JUMPER WIRES TOOLS REQUIRED J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged. The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested. AFL/ECP Connectors AFL/EPC CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 824 - A control module from another vehicle is installed. - Revised software/calibration files have been released for this vehicle. - IMPORTANT: DO NOT re-program the control module with the SAME software/calibration files that are already present in the control module. This is not an effective repair for any type of concern. Verify that the control module contains the correct software/calibration. If incorrect programming is found, reprogram the control module with the most current software/calibration. Refer to Control Module References for replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Testing for Short to Ground TESTING FOR SHORT TO GROUND NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 4. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit. With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is a short to ground in the circuit. Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2. Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). - When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. - If the DMM does not display voltage 4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is shorted. Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A DIGITAL MULTIMETER NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the powertrain control module (PCM), should only be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200 Digital Multimeter (DMM). The J 39200 instruction manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminage even though voltage is present. The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity. IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading. Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the measurement. Page 346 Page 8301 4. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the rear of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. 5. Once the locking tabs are unlocked, slide the inner connector out of the rear of the connector housing. Page 7435 5. Insert the ECM into the retaining slots of the ECM/TCM bracket. 6. Secure the ECM to the bracket ensuring that the ECM retaining tabs (1) are fully engaged. 7. Connect the engine wiring harness electrical connectors to the ECM. Page 3392 Release the lower wiredress cover locking tab. Release the upper wiredress cover locking tab. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. Page 4778 vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide variety of actions, including: - Wiggling the harness - Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting - Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector - Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation - Relocating a harness or wires All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. Another option is, with the component commanded ON and OFF by the scan tool, move related connectors and wiring and observe the component operation. With the engine running, move related connectors and wiring while monitoring engine operation. If harness or connector movement affects the data displayed, component/system operation, or engine operation, inspect and repair the harness/connections as necessary. You may need to load the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these cases you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide good results as well. There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions, along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the circuit to these kinds of conditions. SALT WATER SPRAY Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture. Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5 percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously. HIGH TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070. Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault condition. The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis. This option does not allow for the same control, however. LOW TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect. If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to -18°C (0°F) from one end and +71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized cooling needs. Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or components in an effort to duplicate the concern. DUPLICATING FAILURE CONDITIONS - If none of the previous tests are successful, attempt to duplicate and/or capture the failure conditions. Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, where applicable, contains the conditions that were present when the DTC set. 1. Review and record Freeze Frame/Failure Records data. 2. Clear the DTCs using the scan tool. 3. Turn the key to OFF and wait 15 seconds. 4. Operate the vehicle under the same conditions that were noted in Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, as closely as possible. The vehicle must also be operating within the Conditions for Running the DTC. Refer to Conditions for Running the DTC in the supporting text if a DTC is being diagnosed. 5. Monitor DTC Status for the DTC being tested. The scan tool will indicate Ran, when the enabling conditions have been satisfied long enough for the DTC to run. The scan tool will also indicate whether the DTC passed or failed. - An alternate method is to drive the vehicle with the DMM connected to a suspected circuit. An abnormal reading on the DMM when the concern occurs, may help you locate the concern. Measuring Frequency Page 4580 Utility/Van Zoning UTILITY/VAN ZONING Page 8810 2. Locate the nose piece locking tabs that are positioned on the side of the connector nose piece. The connector nose piece acts as a terminal positive assurance (TPA) and may be referred to as such. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to push in one of the locking tabs while gently pulling on the same side of the nose piece. 4. Repeat the procedure for the other locking tab and remove the nose piece. 5. Remove the wire dress cover. The following is a general procedure for wire dress cover removal. Use this procedure as a guide, some dress cover removal procedures may vary. 6. Use fingers to squeeze the 2 locking legs of the cover. Page 1917 If a wire is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm, etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except coaxial. - Do not use the DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent American wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 8308 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert a small flat-blade tool in the slot below the front loaded terminal position assurance (TPA) and pry up. 3. Remove the TPA by pulling it out of the connector. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-553 (GM P/N 15315247) on a slight upward angle into the cavity below the terminal to be removed. Ensure that the pointed on the end of the tool is facing the bottom of the terminal and it stays in contact with the terminal until it stops on the plastic terminal retainer. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 1903 2. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 7745 Page 3754 TERMINAL REMOVAL Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors. 1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA) device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1). 3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 4. Gently pull the cable and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector. 5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal, refer to Terminal Repair. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3. Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector. REINSTALLING TERMINAL 1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly, refer to Wiring Repairs. 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3. Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) DELPHI CONNECTORS (WEATHER PACK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 868 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the rear TPA from the connector. 7. IMPORTANT: The front TPA cannot be removed from the connector. Only move it to the release point. Use a small flat-blade tool to move the front TPA to the release position. 8. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 9. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Molex Connectors Page 1760 7. The illustration above identifies the entry canal where the terminal release tool will be inserted, and the terminal cavity. - Terminal (1) - Entry Canal (2) 8. Insert the J-38125-553 (15315247) tool into the entry canal and pry up on the terminal retainer. The terminal retainer is a small plastic piece on the top of the terminal. The terminal retainer must be held up while the terminal is pulled out of the connector. Page 9050 REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. The release tab is located on the top of the wiredress cover. View of connector in released position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Page 5731 2. Use a small flat-bladed tool to release the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting the tool in the small recess on the side of the connector and pushing up until the TPA releases from the connector body. The TPA should raise just slightly. Do not try to remove the TPA. IMPORTANT: The TPA on this connector cannot be removed unless the terminals are removed first. The TPA will come out of the connector body, but only slightly. When the TPA is slightly raised the terminals can be removed. Using excessive force to remove the TPA with the terminals still in the connector will damage the connector. 3. Repeat the process for the other side of the connector. 4. Ensure that the TPA is in the proper position to remove the terminals. Page 5986 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully raise the TPA on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA cannot be removed from the connector while there are terminals present in the connector body. View of the TPA when removed from the connector body. 4. Use the J 38125-12A tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the left side of the terminal release cavity as shown in the graphic. Use the tool to move the terminal release to the right with a gentle prying motion. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 8773 Throttle Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids Arrows and Symbols Arrows and Symbols This Service Data uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations. Arrows and Symbols 1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow Basic Knowledge Required GENERAL ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures contained in the service manual. You should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current (amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram, as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. Decimal and Metric Equivalents Decimal and Metric Equivalents Page 2323 3. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. View showing depressing of the lever lock release tab. Page 7534 3. Use a small flat-bladed tool to gently pry off the dress cover by inserting the tool under the cover opposite the harness side and prying up. 4. Remove the cover. 5. Using a small flat-bladed tool, push on the side of the nose piece retainer while pushing the nose piece forward with your thumb. This will release the terminal position assurance (TPA). 6. Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) into the corresponding terminal release cavity. The release cavities are the 2 center rows of cavities on one half of the connector. Page 2202 vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide variety of actions, including: - Wiggling the harness - Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting - Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector - Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation - Relocating a harness or wires All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. Another option is, with the component commanded ON and OFF by the scan tool, move related connectors and wiring and observe the component operation. With the engine running, move related connectors and wiring while monitoring engine operation. If harness or connector movement affects the data displayed, component/system operation, or engine operation, inspect and repair the harness/connections as necessary. You may need to load the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these cases you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide good results as well. There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions, along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the circuit to these kinds of conditions. SALT WATER SPRAY Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture. Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5 percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously. HIGH TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070. Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault condition. The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis. This option does not allow for the same control, however. LOW TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect. If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to -18°C (0°F) from one end and +71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized cooling needs. Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or components in an effort to duplicate the concern. DUPLICATING FAILURE CONDITIONS - If none of the previous tests are successful, attempt to duplicate and/or capture the failure conditions. Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, where applicable, contains the conditions that were present when the DTC set. 1. Review and record Freeze Frame/Failure Records data. 2. Clear the DTCs using the scan tool. 3. Turn the key to OFF and wait 15 seconds. 4. Operate the vehicle under the same conditions that were noted in Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, as closely as possible. The vehicle must also be operating within the Conditions for Running the DTC. Refer to Conditions for Running the DTC in the supporting text if a DTC is being diagnosed. 5. Monitor DTC Status for the DTC being tested. The scan tool will indicate Ran, when the enabling conditions have been satisfied long enough for the DTC to run. The scan tool will also indicate whether the DTC passed or failed. - An alternate method is to drive the vehicle with the DMM connected to a suspected circuit. An abnormal reading on the DMM when the concern occurs, may help you locate the concern. Measuring Frequency Page 5330 Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. FCI Connectors FCI CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 1752 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the rear TPA from the connector. 7. IMPORTANT: The front TPA cannot be removed from the connector. Only move it to the release point. Use a small flat-blade tool to move the front TPA to the release position. 8. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 9. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Molex Connectors Page 8206 If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the DuraSeal splice sleeves. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: - Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. - Do not use the crimp and DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 to crimp DuraSeal splice sleeve. In order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 263 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link). - The wire insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. 5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold them between thumb and forefinger. 7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place. - Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction. - Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip. 8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool closes.Ensure that no strands of wire are cut. 10. Crimp the splice on each end (2). Page 4623 TERMINAL REMOVAL Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors. 1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA) device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1). 3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 4. Gently pull the cable and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector. 5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal, refer to Terminal Repair. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3. Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector. REINSTALLING TERMINAL 1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly, refer to Wiring Repairs. 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3. Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) DELPHI CONNECTORS (WEATHER PACK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 71 Disclaimer Service and Repair Rocker Arm Assembly: Service and Repair Valve Rocker Arm and Push Rod Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Remove the valve rocker arm cover. Refer to Valve Rocker Arm Cover Replacement - Left Side or to Valve Rocker Arm Cover Replacement Right Side. Important: Place the valve rocker arms, pushrods, and pivot support, in a rack so that the can be installed in the same location from which they were removed. 2. Remove the valve rocker arm bolts. 3. Remove the valve rocker arms. 4. Remove the valve rocker arm pivot support. 5. Remove the pushrods. 6. Clean and inspect the valve rocker arms and pushrods. Refer to Valve Rocker Arm and Push Rods Cleaning and Inspection. Installation Procedure Fuel Pressure Relief Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair Fuel Pressure Relief Fuel Pressure Relief Tools Required CH-48027 Digital Pressure Gage With CH-48027 Caution: Refer to Gasoline/Gasoline Vapors Caution. Caution: Remove the fuel tank cap and relieve the fuel system pressure before servicing the fuel system in order to reduce the risk of personal injury. After you relieve the fuel system pressure, a small amount of fuel may be released when servicing the fuel lines, the fuel injection pump, or the connections. In order to reduce the risk of personal injury, cover the fuel system components with a shop towel before disconnection. This will catch any fuel that may leak out. Place the towel in an approved container when the disconnection is complete. 1. Remove the engine cover, if required. 2. Loosen the fuel fill cap in order to relieve the fuel tank vapor pressure. 3. Remove the fuel rail service port cap. Caution: Wrap a shop towel around the fuel pressure connection in order to reduce the risk of fire and personal injury. The towel will absorb any fuel leakage that occurs during the connection of the fuel pressure gage. Place the towel in an approved container when the connection of the fuel pressure gage is complete. 4. Wrap a shop towel around the fuel rail service port. 5. Connect the CH-48027-3 (4) to the fuel rail service port. 6. Connect the CH-48027-2 (2) to the CH-48027-3 (4). 7. Place the hose on the CH-48027-2 (2) into an approved gasoline container. 8. Open the valve on the CH-48027-2 (2) in order to bleed any fuel from the fuel rail. 9. Close the valve on the CH-48027-2 (2). 10. Remove the hose on the CH-48027-2 (2) from the approved gasoline container. Important: If relieving the fuel pressure for the fuel pressure gage installation and removal, it is NOT necessary to proceed with the following steps. Notice: Clean all of the following areas before performing any disconnections in order to avoid possible contamination in the system: * The fuel pipe connections Page 834 IMPORTANT: Ensure that the dress cover and connector body are both in the released position before reassembling. Failure to do so may cause damage to the connector and component. Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (0.64) BOSCH CONNECTORS (0.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While pressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock until the lever is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Pull the rubber boot that covers the wires back to expose the end of the connector dress cover. 4. Place the connector locking lever in the center of the connector. 5. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs that are on the wire end of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover and connector body and pry up. Page 2589 4. Once the front 2 locks are unlocked, lift the front of the dress cover and pull it forward. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the small slot on the TPA and pushing down until the TPA releases. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to angle or rock the J 38125-21 tool when inserting it into the connector or the tool may break. Insert the J 38125-21 (GM P/N 15381651-2) tool into the round canal between the terminals cavities at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to repair Micro 64 connector terminals. The Micro 64 connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-64 (M jaw) was developed to crimp Micro 64 terminals. The J 38125-64 crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. The J 38125-64 crimping tool is also designed to crimp both the wire and the insulation at the same time. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro 64 terminals. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. 1. Cut the wire as close to the damaged terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. Page 8085 Engine Control Module (ECM) C3 (Pin 16 To 59) Page 7353 - Most Molex connectors will have the Molex logo on the dresscover of the connector. In some cases the connectors may have MX followed by another letter. The third letter indicates where the connector was made. A connector with MXD is a Molex connector made in Detroit. Sumitomo has a unique symbol on their connector and possibly a part number. The symbol is similar to that of a diamond lying on its side, similar to that shown. The logo could appear anywhere but the most common place is at the wire side of the housing. Tyco/AMP has many different and unique connector designs. Some may or may not have identifiable marks on them. Page 6084 11. Insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) into the 2 triangular cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 12. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE 1. Prior to installation the terminal must be aligned so the (1) coding lugs align with the (2) coding grooves on the connector. 2. Once the terminal is aligned, slide the terminal into the cavity until the retainer has engaged in the cavity of the connector. 3. Slide the TPA in the connector body and seat it using a small flat bladed tool. The TPA is seated when it is flush with the contact housing. 4. Secure the wires to the connector body using a tie wrap and replace the dress cover and grommet. Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) BOSCH CONNECTORS (2.8 JPT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Pull out the slider on the connector position assurance (CPA) until it is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Oil Filter Adapter Replacement Oil Filter Adapter: Service and Repair Oil Filter Adapter Replacement Oil Filter Adapter Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Remove the oil filter. Refer to Engine Oil and Oil Filter Replacement. 2. Remove the oil filter adapter (1). Installation Procedure Specifications Idle Speed: Specifications Information not supplied by Manufacturer. Page 8505 Page 1508 If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs SIR/SRS WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS, and the wiring components, such as connectors and terminals. IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system terminals. Use either an SIR/SRS pigtail or a terminated lead from the SIR Repair Kit Tray. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves, in order to repair the SIR/SRS wiring - A special crimping tool - A heat torch - An instruction manual The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides the necessary low resistance contact integrity for these sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors SIR/SRS CONNECTOR REPAIR (PLASTIC BODY AND TERMINAL METAL PIN) The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made with a special plating. This plating provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. Use the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit for repairing SIR/SRS terminals and connectors. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the repair kit. The J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit contains: Various terminated leads for sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) terminal replacement - Various connector positive assurance (CPA) locks for SIR/SRS connectors - Base of steering column pigtail connectors part number 12085514 - Yellow vinyl electrical tape Pigtail repair packs are available for SIR/SRS connectors with eight or less terminals. Only the connector body is available for connectors with more than eight terminals. The terminated leads in the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit can be used to replace damaged terminals when replacing the connector body. SIR/SRS COMPONENT WIRE PIGTAIL REPAIR IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails. A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device, not by a connector. If a wiring pigtail is damaged, you must replace the entire component, with pigtail. The inflatable restraint steering wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component. SIR/SRS WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 1902 7. Pressing the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool in the release cavity of the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and crimper in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (DOOR MODULE) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Side view of connector. View of top of connector. 1. Locate the assist lever and lock on the top of the connector. Page 247 Release the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the blue locking tabs on both ends of the connector. Gently slide the TPA up to the released position on both ends. 6. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-13A (GM P/N 12031876-1) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. Page 8875 4. Position the tool J 41364-A onto the park/neutral position switch. Ensure that the 2 slots on the switch where the manual shaft is inserted are lined up with the lower 2 tabs on the tool. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 5. Rotate the tool until the upper locator pin on the tool is lined up with the slot on the top of the switch. Tighten the bolts securing the switch to 25 N.m (18 lb ft). 6. Remove the J 41364-A from the switch. If installing a new switch, remove the positive assurance bracket at this time. 7. Connect the electrical connectors to the switch. 8. Install the transmission control lever to the manual shaft with the nut. Tighten the control lever nut to 25 N.m (18 lb ft). 9. Lower the vehicle. 10. Check the switch for proper operation. The engine must start in the P (Park) or N (Neutral) positions only. If proper operation of the switch can not be obtained, replace the switch. Page 5591 3. Ensure that the terminal release tang access panel is in the correct location to access the terminals. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) into the terminal release tang access slot located behind the access panel of the connector and press down on the terminal while carefully pulling the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Tyco/AMP Connectors (0.25 Cap) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (025 CAP) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component by pressing down on the connector position assurance (CPA). Page 7228 If a wire is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm, etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except coaxial. - Do not use the DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent American wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 1471 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. JST Connectors JST CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, remove the connector from the component. Page 6554 Depress the locks that are located on both sides of the wiredress cover and pull the lever over and past the locks. View of the connector when released from the component. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the front of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool push down on one of the locking tabs and pull the cover up until the dress cover releases. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. Page 5429 6. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs located on the opposite side of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover at the connector end and pry up. 7. Remove the dress cover. 8. Cut the tie wrap on the wire bundle. 9. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting a small flat-bladed tool into the small slot in the end of the slider and pushing on the TPA until it comes out of the connector. When the TPA exits the opposite side of the connector, gasp the TPA and pull it completely out of the connector. 10. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 2836 Figure 1: Full Tread View - "NORMAL" Tire "Feathering" Wear on the Shoulder/Adjacent/Center Ribs Figure 2: Tire Shoulder View Example 1 - "NORMAL" Tire "Feathering" Wear on the Shoulder Figure 3: Tire Shoulder View Example 2 - "NORMAL" Tire "Feathering" Wear Figure 4: Detail Side View of Tire Shoulder Area - "NORMAL" Tire "Feathering" Wear Important When a wheel alignment is deemed necessary for tire wear, be sure to document on the repair order, in as much detail as possible, the severity and type of tire wear (e.g., severe center wear or severe inside or outside shoulder wear) and the position of the tire on the vehicle (RF, LF, LR, RR). Please note the customer's concern with the wear such as, noise, appearance, wear life, etc. A field product report with pictures of the tire wear condition is recommended. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 02-00-89-002J and #07-00-89-036C. 4. Other repairs that affect wheel alignment; e.g., certain component replacement such as suspension control arm replacement, engine cradle adjustment/replace, steering gear replacement, steering tie rod replace, suspension strut/shock, steering knuckle, etc. may require a wheel alignment. Important If other components or repairs are identified as affecting the wheel alignment, policy calls for the wheel alignment labor time to be charged to the replaced/repaired component's labor operation time rather than the wheel alignment labor operations. Important Vibration type customer concerns are generally NOT due to wheel alignment except in the rare cases; e.g., extreme diagonal wear across the tread. In general, wheel alignments are NOT to be performed as an investigation/correction for vibration concerns. "Normal Operation" Conditions Vehicle Lead/Pull Due to Road Crown or Slope: As part of "Normal Operation," vehicles will follow side-to-side or left to right road crown or slope. Be sure to verify from the customer the types of roads they are driving as they may not recognize the influence of road crown on vehicle lead/pull and steering wheel angle. If a vehicle requires significant steering effort to prevent it from "climbing" the road crown there may be an issue to be looked into further. Important Engine - MIL ON P0116/P1400 Set In Very Cold Temps Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Customer Interest Engine - MIL ON P0116/P1400 Set In Very Cold Temps TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 10-06-04-008A Date: January 24, 2011 Subject: Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) Illuminated at Very Cold Ambient Temperatures When Using Engine Coolant Heater, DTC P0116 and/or P1400 Set (Relocate Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor and Engine Coolant Heater Cord) Models: 2006-2007 Buick Rainier 2009 Buick LaCrosse Super, Allure Super (Canada Only) 2006-2010 Cadillac Escalade 2006-2007 Chevrolet Monte Carlo 2006-2009 Chevrolet Impala SS, TrailBlazer 2006-2010 Chevrolet Avalanche, Express, Silverado Tahoe 2006-2009 GMC Envoy 2006-2010 GMC Savana, Sierra, Yukon 2006-2008 Pontiac Grand Prix 2006-2009 Saab 9-7X Equipped with V8 Engine RPO LC9, LH6, LH8, LH9, L76, LS2, LS4, LFA, LZ1, L92, L94, L9H or L20, L96, LMF, LMG, LY2, LY5, LY6 Please Refer to GMVIS Attention: To properly correct this condition, you must follow both of the procedures to relocate the ECT sensor and the engine coolant heater cord. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add cast iron block engine RPOs and to update the Warranty Information coverage period. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 10-06-04-008 (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). Condition Some customers may comment that the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) illuminates after starting the vehicle when they were using the engine coolant heater in very cold ambient temperatures. This usually occurs in a range of -23 to -40°C (-10 to -40°F) or colder. The technician may observe on a scan tool DTC P0116 and/or P1400 set as Current or in History. Cause This condition may be caused by the engine control module (ECM) determining that the ignition OFF time requirement has been met at start-up and interpreting the temperature difference between the engine coolant temperature (ECT) sensor and the intake air temperature (IAT) sensor as being outside of a calibrated range. Correction Important DO NOT replace the ECM for this condition. Relocating the ECT Sensor 1. Turn ON the ignition with the engine OFF. 2. Perform the diagnostic system check - vehicle. Refer to Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle in SI. ‹› If DTC P0116 and/or P1400 are set and the customer WAS using the engine coolant heater, proceed to Step 3. ‹› If DTC P0116 and/or P1400 are set and the customer WAS NOT using the engine coolant heater, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle in SI. 3. Turn OFF the ignition. Warning To avoid being burned, do not remove the radiator cap or surge tank cap while the engine is hot. The cooling system will release scalding fluid and steam Page 8553 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the TPA. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the nose piece. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. Page 1060 Lumbar Adjuster Switch - Passenger (With RPO Code V40) Page 5583 5. Once the nose piece retainers are relaxed, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should raise slightly. 6. On the opposite side of the nose piece, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should release completely. If the nose piece does not come off, repeat the procedure on the opposite side. Page 3219 Fuse Block - Rear, Label Usage Page 7979 Utility/Van Zoning UTILITY/VAN ZONING Page 7411 If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the DuraSeal splice sleeves. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: - Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. - Do not use the crimp and DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 to crimp DuraSeal splice sleeve. In order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 646 8. Take a CLEAR digital picture of the Tech 2(R) Vehicle Information screen showing the engine Calibration IDs and Verification Numbers as shown above. Retain the printout information and the Tech 2(R) screen photograph with the repair order. 9. E-mail a copy of the picture to [email protected]. In the subject line of the e-mail include the phrase "V8 Cal" as well as the complete VIN and Dealer BAC. In the body of the e-mail, include the VIN, mileage, R.O. number and BAC. Include a brief description of the customer concern and cause of the concern. Note The dealer will receive an e-mail reply after the calibrations have been validated. The e-mail reply will advise the dealer if the calibrations are OEM. 10. Allow two hours for the PQC to verify the calibrations and set up the case details. ‹› If the PQC determines that the calibrations ARE aftermarket calibrations, DO NOT contact GM Technical Assistance to discuss warranty concerns on the aftermarket calibrations. ALL questions and concerns about warranty should be directed to the dealers Fixed Operations Manager (FOM), (Warranty Manager (WM) in Canada). 11. You may call the PQC two hours after submitting the e-mail for authorization to replace the assembly. This will provide them time to receive, review and set up a case on the request. Please be prepared to provide all the usual documentation that is normally required when requesting an assembly authorization from the PQC. Tech 2(R) Displaying All Zeroes for the Verification Numbers on the Calibration ID and Verification Number Screen If the Tech 2(R) that you are using displays all zeroes for the Verification Numbers as shown, then perform the following steps: 1. Update the Tech 2(R) with the latest software from TIS2WEB. 2. Turn OFF the ignition for 90 seconds. 3. Connect the Tech 2(R) to the vehicle. 4. Turn ON the ignition, and build the vehicle. Observe the Tech 2(R) Calibration ID and Verification Number screen for proper operation. ‹› If the Tech 2(R) screen still does not display properly, then turn OFF the ignition for 90 seconds again. Turn ON the ignition and observe the same screen for proper operation. Retrieving Calibrations From a Global A Vehicle This information applies to the 2010 Camaro and is typical of the procedure that will be used on Global A vehicles. 1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Connect the MDI to the Data Link Connector (DLC) of the vehicle. Note Use the USB port to make the following MDI connection: Page 6523 Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Page 6430 6. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs located on the opposite side of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover at the connector end and pry up. 7. Remove the dress cover. 8. Cut the tie wrap on the wire bundle. 9. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting a small flat-bladed tool into the small slot in the end of the slider and pushing on the TPA until it comes out of the connector. When the TPA exits the opposite side of the connector, gasp the TPA and pull it completely out of the connector. 10. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 1250 Headlamp Switch: Service and Repair HEADLAMP SWITCH REPLACEMENT REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Open the left instrument panel (IP) access cover. 2. Reach into the access hole and release the 4 retaining tabs located on the headlamp switch behind the IP. 3. Remove the headlamp switch from the IP, through the IP access hole. 4. Disconnect the electrical connectors from the headlamp switch. 5. Remove the headlamp from the IP. INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 1. Position the headlamp switch near the access hole. 2. Connect the electrical connectors to the headlamp switch. 3. Install the headlamp switch to the IP. Ensure that the retaining tabs are fully seated. 4. Install the left IP access cover. Page 4807 Depress the locks that are located on both sides of the wiredress cover and pull the lever over and past the locks. View of the connector when released from the component. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the front of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool push down on one of the locking tabs and pull the cover up until the dress cover releases. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. Page 6588 2. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 5639 20. Extract a portion of the ECT sensor harness wiring and connector from the protective conduit. Cut off the ECT sensor harness connector and wiring. 21. Determine a routing path for the ECT sensor jumper harness wires so that they can be secured TO or WITHIN an existing protective conduit. Note This step is to set up and verify the length of wiring that is required before cutting. 22. Route the ECT sensor jumper wires and then enclose them in their own protective conduit in order to VERIFY the length that is required. 23. Cut the ECT sensor jumper wires to the appropriate length. Note Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splice or connector. 24. Splice the ECT sensor jumper wires to the ORIGINAL ECT HARNESS LOCATION using DuraSeal weatherproof splices. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves in SI. Note Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splice or connector. 25. Splice the ECT sensor jumper wires to the ECT SENSOR HARNESS CONNECTOR using DuraSeal weatherproof splices. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves in SI. 26. Connect the ECT sensor harness connector to the ECT sensor. 27. Secure the ECT sensor jumper wires that are in their own protective conduit TO or WITHIN the existing harness conduit using tie straps. Important You MUST run the engine at the specified RPM and until it reaches normal operating temperature and then allow it to idle as indicated in SI. The engine MUST then be allowed to cool down in order to top off the coolant level as needed. 28. Fill the cooling system to the proper level. Refer to Cooling System Draining and Filling in SI. 29. Pressure test the cooling system. Refer to Cooling System Leak Testing in SI. 30. Use a scan tool to clear any DTCs. Relocating the Engine Coolant Heater Cord Important For reference, the procedure and graphics that are shown are from a Chevrolet Silverado, but are similar for the other vehicles listed above. 1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Ask the customer where they would prefer the extension cord to exit from the engine compartment in order to determine the required extension cord length. 3. Obtain an extension cord with the following features: - 120 volt - 14/3 gauge - 15A capacity - Three prong - Polarized plug and receptacle - Chemical resistant - Grounded terminals - Designed for use in a cold outdoor environment - Outer jacket resistant to deterioration from moisture, abrasion and exposure to sunlight - Maximum length of 2.5-3 m (8-10 ft) 4. Release enough of the clips that retain the engine coolant heater cord to the vehicle to provide the necessary length for repositioning. 5. Apply dielectric grease to the electrical contacts of the heater cord receptacle and the extension cord plug to prevent corrosion. Use GM P/N 12345579 (in Canada, use P/N 10953481) or an equivalent. 6. Connect the heater cord receptacle to the extension cord plug and wipe OFF any excess grease. Page 8375 Checking Aftermarket Accessories CHECKING AFTERMARKET ACCESSORIES Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits: - CAUTION: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol. - NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice. OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol. Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the cause of the problems. Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include: Power feeds connected to points other than the battery - Antenna location - Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring - Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line - Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories. Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions INDUCING INTERMITTENT FAULT CONDITIONS TOOLS REQUIRED J 25070 Heat Gun Many intermittent open or shorted circuits are affected by harness/connector movement that is caused by vibration, engine torque, bumps/rough pavement, etc. In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness if the malfunction appears to be Page 4655 Release the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the blue locking tabs on both ends of the connector. Gently slide the TPA up to the released position on both ends. 6. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-13A (GM P/N 12031876-1) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. Page 5500 5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape. Seat Belt Schematic Icons Seat Belt Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons Page 2761 Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 3. Install the sensor nut and position the sensor body parallel to the inside wheel surface while torquing. Tighten the sensor nut to 7 N.m (62 lb in). Important: Before reinstalling the tire on the wheel, note the following items to avoid tire pressure sensor damage upon tire mounting. ^ Position the mounting/dismounting head 180 degrees from the valve stem. ^ Position the bead transition area 45 degrees counterclockwise of the valve stem. ^ Using the tire machine, rotate the tire/wheel assembly clockwise when transferring the tire bead to the inside of the wheel rim. ^ Repeat items for outer bead. Install the tire on the wheel. Refer to Tire Mounting and Dismounting. Important: A service replacement tire pressure sensor is shipped in OFF mode. In this mode the sensor's unique identification code cannot be learned into the passenger door modules (PDMs) memory. The sensor must be taken out of OFF mode by spinning the tire/wheel assembly above 32 km/h (20 mph) in order to close the sensors internal roll switch for at least 10 seconds. 4. Install the tire/wheel assembly on the vehicle. Refer to Tire and Wheel Removal and Installation. 5. Lower the vehicle. 6. Learn the tire pressure sensors. Refer to Tire Pressure Sensor Learn. Page 699 6. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs located on the opposite side of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover at the connector end and pry up. 7. Remove the dress cover. 8. Cut the tie wrap on the wire bundle. 9. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting a small flat-bladed tool into the small slot in the end of the slider and pushing on the TPA until it comes out of the connector. When the TPA exits the opposite side of the connector, gasp the TPA and pull it completely out of the connector. 10. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 8379 Refer to the following table as a guide in selecting the correct test adapter for front probing connectors: Backprobe IMPORTANT: Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures. - Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector. - Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large of a test probe. - After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected, test for proper terminal contact. Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the connector. Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure SCAN TOOL SNAPSHOT PROCEDURE Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used Page 1866 - Yazaki has a wedge or arrow shape, similar to that shown. Delphi Connectors (Micro .64) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro 64 connectors. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. The lever lock may be located on the top or sides of the wire dress cover. Page 1336 - JST connectors have JST in small letters on their connectors, similar to that above. The location of the logo will vary with the connector size and style. - Kostel has an "LK" with a circle around it. These connector are usually used as a transmissions connection and are currently use on some Cadillac vehicles. Page 391 7. Apply pressure and gently rock the cover until one locking leg is unseated. 8. Continue to apply pressure and rock the cover until the second locking leg is unseated. Repeat procedure for the other side of the dress cover and remove the cover. 9. Use J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) to gently lift the terminal retaining tab while gently pulling the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 10. If the terminal is severely bent or damaged, it may be possible on some connectors to push the wire out of the front of the connector instead of Page 7958 Note The rivet stud and surrounding panel area MUST BE properly refinished PRIOR to the installation of the electrical ground wire terminal and conductive nut to maintain a secure, stable and corrosion-free electrical ground. 11. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and Repair in SI. 12. Allow the refinished repair area to cure sufficiently before removing the protective material applied to the rivet stud threads. 13. Remove the painters tape or equivalent from the rivet stud threads. 14. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, thoroughly clean the rivet stud threads to remove any adhesive and allow to dry. 15. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M6 conductive rivet stud. Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase. 16. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground wire terminal. 17. Install the electrical ground wire terminal to the M6 conductive rivet stud. 18. Select a M6 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 19. Install the M6 conductive nut to the rivet stud and: Tighten Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb in) 20. Verify proper system operation. Parts Information Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use: Warranty Information (Saab Models) Page 2120 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert terminal into the appropriate terminal holder until it hits bottom and stops. The correct terminal holder is determined by the wire size. Also ensure that the terminals wings are pointing towards the former on the tool and the release locator. 5. Insert the stripped cable into the terminal. Insulation should be visible on both sides of the terminal insulation wings. 6. Compress the handles until the ratchet automatically releases. 7. Place the terminal into the appropriate cavity and assemble the connector. Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO-PACK 100W) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W connectors. These connectors are very similar but use different terminals and have some minor physical differences also. Page 8589 If a wire is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm, etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except coaxial. - Do not use the DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent American wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 4858 Open the harness by removing any tape. 2. Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. 3. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 4. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent american wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 5. Slide a section of high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing down the length of wire to be spliced. Ensure that the shrink tubing will not interfere with the splice procedure. 6. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 7. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. 8. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 9. Insert the wire into the DuraSeal splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 10. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Page 2330 IMPORTANT: Ensure that the dress cover and connector body are both in the released position before reassembling. Failure to do so may cause damage to the connector and component. Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (0.64) BOSCH CONNECTORS (0.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While pressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock until the lever is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Pull the rubber boot that covers the wires back to expose the end of the connector dress cover. 4. Place the connector locking lever in the center of the connector. 5. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs that are on the wire end of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover and connector body and pry up. Page 1618 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. 4. Remove the dress cover by using a flat bladed tool to release the dress cover locking tabs and lift up on the dress cover. 5. Cut the tie wrap that holds the wires to the connector body. Page 1747 2. Locate the two indents of the terminal position assurance (TPA) located on the bottom of the connector body. Page 3927 Tighten the nuts to 8 N.m (71 lb in). 14. Fill the cooling system. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System (LL8) Draining and Filling Cooling System (LH6, LS2). Page 7656 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the rear TPA from the connector. 7. IMPORTANT: The front TPA cannot be removed from the connector. Only move it to the release point. Use a small flat-blade tool to move the front TPA to the release position. 8. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 9. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Molex Connectors Page 5953 difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Bosch Connectors (ECM) BOSCH CONNECTORS (ECM) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the assist lever on the top of the connector. Move the assist lever to the forward position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 2130 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the TPA. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the nose piece. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. Page 1189 Solar Sensor: Service and Repair Sun Load Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Remove the I/P upper trim pad. 2. Remove the sun load sensor from the I/P upper trim pad by turning counter clockwise. 3. Disconnect the electrical connector from the sun load sensor. Installation Procedure 1. Connect the electrical connector to the sun load sensor. 2. Install the sun load sensor to the I/P upper trim pad by turning clockwise. 3. Install the I/P upper trim pad. Page 3331 Fuse Block - Underhood (5.3L/6.0L), Label Usage Page 7149 Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Page 4665 The engine harness may be repaired using the J-38125. High Temperature Wiring Repairs HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperatures, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time may use materials i.e. wires, connectors, and shielding that has a higher heat rating than typical wiring. When making a repair in a high temperature area observe the following: Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature to replace any damaged wire. - Replace any heat shielding that is removed. - Cover any DuraSeal splice sleeves with SCT1 shrink tubing (available in the J-38125 Terminal Repair kit). - After making a wiring repair, ensure that the location of the wiring is not moved closer to the heat source. IDENTIFYING HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperature, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time need special considerations when making wiring repairs. Areas that may be exposed to higher temperatures can be identified by heat resistant materials that are being used in those areas. These materials may include heat reflective tape, moon tape, and high temperature shrink tubing. Also conduit and other protective coverings may be used. Because conduit or similar coverings are used throughout the vehicle regardless of the temperature, it may be necessary for the technician to determine if an area is exposed to excessive heat before making a wiring repair. Obvious areas of consideration would be any area located near the exhaust manifolds, catalytic converter, and exhaust pipes. The J-38125 contains much of the material you will need to perform repairs on areas exposed to high heat. The kit contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves to crimp and seal connections - High temperature SCT1 shrink tubing to protect the splice sleeves - A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct crimp tool to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools to remove the terminals from the connectors The J-38125 does not contain wire that is suitable to high temperature exposure. Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature of the same or larger gage size as the original wire when repair damage wire. Also replace any reflective tape that you remove during the repair. HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature rating of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125 and then encapsulate the splice sleeve using the high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the order listed. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip keeping all of the wire strands intact. Page 5364 Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size. REPAIRING A FUSIBLE LINK IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient overload protection. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. Flat Wire Repairs FLAT WIRE REPAIRS NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced. GMLAN Wiring Repairs GMLAN WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The GM Local Area Network (GMLAN) System requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working on GMLAN connectors and terminals. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items in order to repair the GMLAN wiring: Dura Seal splice sleeves - A wire stripping tool - J 38125-8 Crimping Tool (GM P/N 12085115) - J 38125-5 Ultra Torch Special Tool (GM P/N 12085116) The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. - A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors GMLAN REPAIRS IMPORTANT: When making a repair to any GMLAN network, the original wire length after the repair must be the same length as before the repair. If the network is a twisted pair, the twist must be maintained after the repair is completed. GMLAN has 2 types of networks, low speed and high speed. Low speed GMLAN has a single wire and works at slow speeds. High speed GMLAN has 2 wires in a twisted pair and works at higher speeds. For more information on GMLAN, refer to Data Link Communications Description and Operation. GMLAN CONNECTOR TERMINAL REPAIR IMPORTANT: A service terminal can be used to replace damaged connector terminals for both high speed and low speed GMLAN systems. When making a connector terminal repair on a GMLAN high speed system with twisted pair wires, do not untwist the wires more than necessary to make the repair. The terminals in the GMLAN system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are available in the J-38125. If the individual terminals are damaged on any GMLAN connection, use the appropriate connector repair procedure in order to repair the terminal. GMLAN WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 2306 Specifications Engine Oil Pressure: Specifications Oil Pressure - Minimum - Hot .................................................................................................................................................. 41 kPa at 1,000 engine RPM (6 psig at 1,000 engine RPM) .............................................................................................................................................. 124 kPa at 2,000 engine RPM (18 psig at 2,000 engine RPM) .............................................................................................................................................. 165 kPa at 4,000 engine RPM (24 psig at 4,000 engine RPM) Active Fuel Management Relief Valve Oil Pressure - as Measured at Oil Pressure Sensor Location ........................... 379-517 kPa Maximum (55-75 psig Maximum) Page 8299 7. Pressing the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool in the release cavity of the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and crimper in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (DOOR MODULE) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Side view of connector. View of top of connector. 1. Locate the assist lever and lock on the top of the connector. Page 3272 TERMINAL REMOVAL Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors. 1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA) device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1). 3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 4. Gently pull the cable and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector. 5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal, refer to Terminal Repair. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3. Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector. REINSTALLING TERMINAL 1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly, refer to Wiring Repairs. 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3. Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) DELPHI CONNECTORS (WEATHER PACK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 418 3. Use a small flat-bladed tool to gently pry off the dress cover by inserting the tool under the cover opposite the harness side and prying up. 4. Remove the cover. 5. Using a small flat-bladed tool, push on the side of the nose piece retainer while pushing the nose piece forward with your thumb. This will release the terminal position assurance (TPA). 6. Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) into the corresponding terminal release cavity. The release cavities are the 2 center rows of cavities on one half of the connector. Page 3323 6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias. Reference the appropriate service manual wiring schematic to obtain the correct diode installation position. 7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for the soldering equipment. 8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed. 9. IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode attachment points with tape. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape. Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable SPLICING TWISTED OR SHIELDED CABLE Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable. 1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splice is made. 3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire. Staggering the splices by 65 mm (2.5 in) is recommended. 4. IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical contact with the drain wire. Re-assemble the cable. Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape. - Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1). - Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire. - Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape. Page 8279 Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. FCI Connectors FCI CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 1317 If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200 DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J 39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected. IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J 39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and maximum (MAX) values measured. 1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of a suspected circuit to the other. 2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J 39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep). IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value in order to record the full change. 5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling the connections or the wiring, test driving, or performing other operations. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions. 6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9. Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist. Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections TESTING FOR INTERMITTENT CONDITIONS AND POOR CONNECTIONS TOOLS REQUIRED - J 35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit - J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit When the condition is not currently present, but is indicated in DTC history, the cause may be intermittent. An intermittent may also be the cause when there is a customer complaint, but the symptom cannot be duplicated. Refer to the Symptom Table of the system that is suspect of causing the condition before trying to locate an intermittent condition. Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the following items: Wiring broken inside the insulation - Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector - Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself, and corrosion in the wire to terminal contact area, etc. - Pierced or damaged insulation can allow moisture to enter the wiring causing corrosion. The conductor can corrode inside the insulation, with little visible evidence. Look for swollen and stiff sections of wire in the suspect circuits. - Wiring which has been pinched, cut, or its insulation rubbed through may cause an intermittent open or short as the bare area touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle. - Wiring that comes in contact with hot or exhaust components - Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required, in order to verify the customer concern. - Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. - Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis and Vehicle Data Recorder operation. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any inline connectors before replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation. Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination, usually in the underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit. Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper adapter. Always use the J 35616 when probing connectors. Other causes of terminal deformation are improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT IN BUSSED ELECTRICAL CENTERS (BEC) Page 4785 - A control module from another vehicle is installed. - Revised software/calibration files have been released for this vehicle. - IMPORTANT: DO NOT re-program the control module with the SAME software/calibration files that are already present in the control module. This is not an effective repair for any type of concern. Verify that the control module contains the correct software/calibration. If incorrect programming is found, reprogram the control module with the most current software/calibration. Refer to Control Module References for replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Testing for Short to Ground TESTING FOR SHORT TO GROUND NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 4. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit. With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is a short to ground in the circuit. Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2. Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). - When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. - If the DMM does not display voltage 4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is shorted. Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A DIGITAL MULTIMETER NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the powertrain control module (PCM), should only be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200 Digital Multimeter (DMM). The J 39200 instruction manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminage even though voltage is present. The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity. IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading. Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the measurement. Locations Camshaft Position Sensor: Locations Engine Controls Component Views Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor 1 - Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor 2 - C110 Diagram Information and Instructions Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions Electrical Symbols Page 8725 View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. 4. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers CIRCUIT PROTECTION - CIRCUIT BREAKERS A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types of circuit Page 3692 The identification tag on the rear half of the transfer case provides the information shown. Disclaimer Page 5944 If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200 DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J 39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected. IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J 39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and maximum (MAX) values measured. 1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of a suspected circuit to the other. 2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J 39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep). IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value in order to record the full change. 5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling the connections or the wiring, test driving, or performing other operations. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions. 6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9. Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist. Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections TESTING FOR INTERMITTENT CONDITIONS AND POOR CONNECTIONS TOOLS REQUIRED - J 35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit - J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit When the condition is not currently present, but is indicated in DTC history, the cause may be intermittent. An intermittent may also be the cause when there is a customer complaint, but the symptom cannot be duplicated. Refer to the Symptom Table of the system that is suspect of causing the condition before trying to locate an intermittent condition. Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the following items: Wiring broken inside the insulation - Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector - Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself, and corrosion in the wire to terminal contact area, etc. - Pierced or damaged insulation can allow moisture to enter the wiring causing corrosion. The conductor can corrode inside the insulation, with little visible evidence. Look for swollen and stiff sections of wire in the suspect circuits. - Wiring which has been pinched, cut, or its insulation rubbed through may cause an intermittent open or short as the bare area touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle. - Wiring that comes in contact with hot or exhaust components - Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required, in order to verify the customer concern. - Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. - Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis and Vehicle Data Recorder operation. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any inline connectors before replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation. Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination, usually in the underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit. Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper adapter. Always use the J 35616 when probing connectors. Other causes of terminal deformation are improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT IN BUSSED ELECTRICAL CENTERS (BEC) Page 199 Connector Anatomy Connector Repairs contains a list of all connector repairs. The connector repairs are listed by the connector manufacturer and then by connector type. If the technician cannot identify the manufacturer of the connector, refer to Identifying Connectors below. Knowing the connector manufacturer will assist in finding the correct connector repair from the following list: - Connector Position Assurance Locks - Terminal Position Assurance Locks - Bosch Connectors (0.64) Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) Bosch Connectors (BSK) Bosch Connectors (ECM) - Delphi Connectors (Micro.64) Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) Delphi Connectors (12-Way) - Tyco/AMP Connectors (CM 42-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) Tyco/AMP Connectors (025 Cap) Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) - Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) - Repairing Connector Terminals IDENTIFYING CONNECTORS Knowing the connector manufacturer is helpful when trying to locating the correct connector repair procedure. There are many different connector designs used on GM vehicles and it is sometimes difficult to identify the connector manufacturer. The information in this document should help with the identification of connector manufactures. The following connector manufacturers make most of the connectors found in GM vehicles: AFL/EPC (Alcoa Fujikura Ltd./Engineered Plastics Components) - Bosch - Delphi - FCI (Framatome Connectors International) - JAE (Japan Aviation Electronics) - JST (Japan Solderless Terminals) Page 6045 Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Heated Oxygen Sensor Replacement - Bank 2 Sensor 1 Heated Oxygen Sensor Replacement - Bank 2 Sensor 1 Removal Procedure Notice: Refer to Heated Oxygen and Oxygen Sensor Notice. Notice: Refer to Excessive Force and Oxygen Sensor Notice. 1. Raise and suitably support the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Unscrew the heated oxygen sensor (HO2S) sensor from the catalytic converter. 3. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) retainer. 4. Disconnect the HO2S electrical connector (2). Installation Procedure Page 5657 Page 8546 7. Apply pressure and gently rock the cover until one locking leg is unseated. 8. Continue to apply pressure and rock the cover until the second locking leg is unseated. Repeat procedure for the other side of the dress cover and remove the cover. 9. Use J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) to gently lift the terminal retaining tab while gently pulling the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 10. If the terminal is severely bent or damaged, it may be possible on some connectors to push the wire out of the front of the connector instead of Page 3443 Page 6727 Release the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the blue locking tabs on both ends of the connector. Gently slide the TPA up to the released position on both ends. 6. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-13A (GM P/N 12031876-1) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. Page 7118 7. Wrap electrical tape around the connection as shown. 8. Route the engine coolant heater cord and extension cord behind the alternator and adjacent to the engine coolant crossover pipe as shown. 9. Continue to route the extension cord to the exit location desired by the customer as shown. 10. Review the routing of the coolant heater cord and extension cord to verify that it does not touch any sharp edges that could damage it. 11. Secure the engine coolant heater cord and the extension cord with tie straps as needed. 12. Resecure any of the original clips that retained the engine coolant heater cord to the vehicle that were released to provide length. Part Information The extension cord may be obtained at any of the following outlets: - Lowes* - Home Depot* - Canada: Acklands-Grainger* (www.acklandsgrainger.com), Catalogue Part Number: CWRSJTOW3C14-10 USA: Cords should bear the UL symbol. Canada: Cords should bear the ULc symbol or CSA approval. *We believe these sources and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume any responsibility for the products or material from these firms or for any such items that may be available from other sources. Page 7068 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 6735 If a wire is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm, etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except coaxial. - Do not use the DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent American wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 7926 Important The M6 conductive rivet stud as shown, can accommodate a panel thickness range of 0.7-4.2 mm (0.03-0.17 in). If there are layers of sheet metal, they should be touching without any air gaps to ensure a good ground. 5. Select a M6 conductive rivet stud. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. Note Use the GE-50317 rivet stud tool kit. 6. Place the M6 conductive rivet stud (1) in the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole. Assemble the rivet stud tool (2) with the groove and flare side facing the rivet stud, then the washer and the M6 nut (3). 7. Using a wrench on the rivet stud tool, and a socket on the M6 nut, secure the M6 conductive rivet stud. 8. Ensure the rivet stud is securely fastened, WITHOUT ANY detectable movement. 9. Completely wrap the threads of the rivet stud with painters tape or equivalent. Note The rivet stud and surrounding panel area MUST BE properly refinished PRIOR to the installation of the ground wire terminal and conductive nut to maintain a secure, stable and corrosion-free electrical ground. 10. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and Repair in SI. 11. Allow the refinished repair area to cure sufficiently before removing the protective material applied to the rivet stud threads. 12. Remove the painters tape or equivalent from the rivet stud threads. 13. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, thoroughly clean the rivet stud threads to remove any adhesive and allow to dry. 14. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M6 conductive rivet stud. Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase. Page 2933 Step 1 - Step 6 Page 6149 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the DuraSeal splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of a connector. CPAs are used in all SIR System connectors and also in some connectors of other systems. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals of a connection. TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE CLIPS IMPORTANT: When making a splice in an area that may be exposed to moisture use a crimp and seal splice sleeve instead of a Splice Clip. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. Page 2724 Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair Key and Lock Cylinder Coding Use Instruction Sheet Supplied For the lock cylinder coding procedure, refer to the instruction sheet supplied in the lock cylinder kit. For key cutting information, refer to the instructions provided from the manufacturer of the key cutting equipment used. Page 5156 to analyze the data during the time a vehicle condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a trigger point that you have determined. Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2 snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a first-in, first-out basis. If a third snapshot is taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost. Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types: Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice - Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200 frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not lost if the Scan Tool is powered down. The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis. The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected values by plotting 3 parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful, especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC. Testing for a Short to Voltage TESTING FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4. Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt, there is a short to voltage in the circuit. Testing for Continuity TESTING FOR CONTINUITY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6. Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit. 7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity. With a Test Lamp IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits. 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6. If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity. Testing for Electrical Intermittents TESTING FOR ELECTRICAL INTERMITTENTS Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment. - Testing for Short to Ground - Testing for Continuity - Testing for a Short to Voltage Page 8606 Page 7988 Refer to the following table as a guide in selecting the correct test adapter for front probing connectors: Backprobe IMPORTANT: Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures. - Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector. - Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large of a test probe. - After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected, test for proper terminal contact. Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the connector. Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure SCAN TOOL SNAPSHOT PROCEDURE Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used Page 5032 Installation Procedure 1. Install the catalytic converter (1) in reverse order of removal by starting with the catalytic converter outlet pipe angled toward the left side of the vehicle and positioning the right side catalytic converter pipe above the frame. Rotate the catalytic converter outlet pipe toward the rear of the vehicle and lift the left side catalytic converter pipe up above the frame. Then position the catalytic converter (1) to the exhaust manifolds. 2. Install the exhaust hanger insulators to the exhaust system. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 3. Install the exhaust muffler nuts. Ensure the catalytic converter is held in the installed position before tightening the nuts. Tighten the nuts to 45 N.m (33 lb ft). Locations Impact Sensor: Locations SIR Component Views Inflatable Restraint Side Impact Sensor (SIS) - Left 1 - Driver Door 2 - Left Front Door Harness 3 - Inflatable Restraint Side Impact Sensor (SIS) - Left Inflatable Restraint Side Impact Sensor (SIS) - Right Page 3036 6. Heater outlet hose to engine (6). 7. Heater inlet hose to front of dash (7). 8. Heater outlet hose to front of dash (8). Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models) Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models) Page 9059 MOLEX CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. 2. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. Page 6740 If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs SIR/SRS WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS, and the wiring components, such as connectors and terminals. IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system terminals. Use either an SIR/SRS pigtail or a terminated lead from the SIR Repair Kit Tray. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves, in order to repair the SIR/SRS wiring - A special crimping tool - A heat torch - An instruction manual The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides the necessary low resistance contact integrity for these sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors SIR/SRS CONNECTOR REPAIR (PLASTIC BODY AND TERMINAL METAL PIN) The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made with a special plating. This plating provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. Use the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit for repairing SIR/SRS terminals and connectors. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the repair kit. The J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit contains: Various terminated leads for sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) terminal replacement - Various connector positive assurance (CPA) locks for SIR/SRS connectors - Base of steering column pigtail connectors part number 12085514 - Yellow vinyl electrical tape Pigtail repair packs are available for SIR/SRS connectors with eight or less terminals. Only the connector body is available for connectors with more than eight terminals. The terminated leads in the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit can be used to replace damaged terminals when replacing the connector body. SIR/SRS COMPONENT WIRE PIGTAIL REPAIR IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails. A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device, not by a connector. If a wiring pigtail is damaged, you must replace the entire component, with pigtail. The inflatable restraint steering wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component. SIR/SRS WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 3270 pulling it through. This will prevent damage to the internal seals of the connector. Once the terminal is pushed out of the connector, cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible and pull the wire through the connector. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE The Micro-Pack 100W connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool was developed to crimp Micro-Pack 100W terminals. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 2. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert the terminal into the crimp tool until the core wings are flush with the anvil on the crimp tool. Be sure that the wings are pointed toward the crimp tool former and release the spring locator. The locator will hold the terminal in place. Inspect the alignment of the terminal wings with the crimp tool former. If the terminal wings are wider than the crimp tool former, remove the terminal and bend the terminal wings in slightly. 5. Place stripped wire into terminal. 6. Crimp the new terminal to the wire. If a jam occurs, press the emergency release to open applicator. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire perform the following procedure in order to replace Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. Page 4851 2. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully push the terminal position assurance (TPA) towards the face of the connector on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA is fragile and may break if not done carefully. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. 3. Use the J 38125-215 tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 718 TERMINAL REMOVAL Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors. 1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA) device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1). 3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 4. Gently pull the cable and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector. 5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal, refer to Terminal Repair. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3. Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector. REINSTALLING TERMINAL 1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly, refer to Wiring Repairs. 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3. Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) DELPHI CONNECTORS (WEATHER PACK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 3919 Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under the 5 year / 100,000 mile (160,000 km) emission warranty, use: Warranty Information (Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 2914 Spark Plug: Application and ID Spark Plug Type.............................................................................................................................................GM P/N 12571164 AC Spark Plug P/N 41-985 Page 6763 Fuel Pressure: Vehicle Damage Warnings Fuel Pressure Notice Notice: Do not allow the fuel pressure to exceed the specified value because damage to the fuel pressure regulator or the fuel pressure gage may result. Page 2937 Step 11 - Step 17 Page 8963 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert a small flat-blade tool in the slot below the front loaded terminal position assurance (TPA) and pry up. 3. Remove the TPA by pulling it out of the connector. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-553 (GM P/N 15315247) on a slight upward angle into the cavity below the terminal to be removed. Ensure that the pointed on the end of the tool is facing the bottom of the terminal and it stays in contact with the terminal until it stops on the plastic terminal retainer. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 7170 11. Insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) into the 2 triangular cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 12. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE 1. Prior to installation the terminal must be aligned so the (1) coding lugs align with the (2) coding grooves on the connector. 2. Once the terminal is aligned, slide the terminal into the cavity until the retainer has engaged in the cavity of the connector. 3. Slide the TPA in the connector body and seat it using a small flat bladed tool. The TPA is seated when it is flush with the contact housing. 4. Secure the wires to the connector body using a tie wrap and replace the dress cover and grommet. Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) BOSCH CONNECTORS (2.8 JPT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Pull out the slider on the connector position assurance (CPA) until it is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 4640 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry one side of the nose piece up to the pre-stage position. When the nose piece is in the pre-staged position, the nose piece will be raised above the connector body the length of the step in the nose piece. 7. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry the other side of the piece to the pre-stage position. If the nose piece is higher than the first step in the nose piece, gently push down on the nose piece until it meets with resistance from the connector body, you should feel the nose piece click into position. Page 4796 6. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs located on the opposite side of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover at the connector end and pry up. 7. Remove the dress cover. 8. Cut the tie wrap on the wire bundle. 9. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting a small flat-bladed tool into the small slot in the end of the slider and pushing on the TPA until it comes out of the connector. When the TPA exits the opposite side of the connector, gasp the TPA and pull it completely out of the connector. 10. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 8329 Page 5815 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. 4. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front of the connector. Page 1334 - Kostel - Molex - Sumitomo - Tyco/AMP - Yazaki Identifying the manufacturer of a connector is often difficult. When trying to determine the manufacturer of a connector, look for specific identifying marks that are unique to that connector supplier. Most of these identify marks are hard to find or see. Check the connector carefully and refer to the information below for pictures and descriptions of connector identification markings. - Most of AFLs connectors have EPC on their connector body. Some of the smaller connectors will not have any markings on them. - In some cases Bosch will actually be printed on the connector. If Bosch does not appear on the connector, look for the Bosch logo. The Bosch logo is a circle with a blunted arrow inside. This logo can appear anywhere on the connector and is often very small. Page 4951 2. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 1000 Lock Cylinder Switch: Diagrams Immobilizer Connector End Views Passlock Sensor (w/o BAE) Page 4237 Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 7. Install the timing chain tensioner (232) and bolts (231). Tighten the timing chain tensioner bolts to 25 N.m (18 lb ft). Important: ^ The sprocket teeth and timing chain must mesh. ^ The camshaft and the crankshaft sprocket alignment marks MUST be aligned properly. Install the camshaft sprocket (205), timing chain (208), and bolt (206). Page 3710 Page 5034 Notice: Refer to Component Fastener Tightening Notice. Important: If the HO2S sensor is connected to the main wiring harness during installation. Rotate the HO2S sensor several turns counterclockwise before threading the HO2S sensor into the catalytic converter. This action of initially reverse winding of the pigtail wires will prevent a condition where the HO2S sensor pigtail wires become severely twisted or binding once the HO2S sensor is installed into the catalytic converter. 11. Install both front HO2S sensors (1) to the catalytic converter. Tighten the sensor to 42 N.m (31 lb ft). 12. Install both rear HO2S (2) to the catalytic converter. Tighten the sensor to 42 N.m (31 lb ft). 13. Lower the vehicle. Page 394 TERMINAL REMOVAL Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors. 1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA) device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1). 3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 4. Gently pull the cable and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector. 5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal, refer to Terminal Repair. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3. Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector. REINSTALLING TERMINAL 1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly, refer to Wiring Repairs. 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3. Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) DELPHI CONNECTORS (WEATHER PACK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 7231 Open the harness by removing any tape. 2. Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. 3. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 4. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent american wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 5. Slide a section of high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing down the length of wire to be spliced. Ensure that the shrink tubing will not interfere with the splice procedure. 6. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 7. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. 8. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 9. Insert the wire into the DuraSeal splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 10. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Page 4772 Utility/Van Zoning UTILITY/VAN ZONING Page 7505 The first connector design of the Micro-Pack 100W (1) has a white connector interface that holds the terminals. The second design of the Micro-Pack 100W (2) has a gray interface to hold the terminals. Also, the first design has terminal cavities that are further apart (3 mm centerline) and offset from the other row of terminal cavities in the connector. The second design has terminals cavities that are closer together (2.54 mm centerline) and aligned vertically. One other way to identify the second design is the thin strip of material that runs along the outside of the cavities. IMPORTANT: There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W terminals which are very similar. Ensure that you have the correct terminal before crimping the new terminal to the wire. The first design connector uses the longer terminal (1) that has a raised area in front of the recess in the terminal. The second design connector uses the shorter terminal without the raised area. Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro-Pack 100W connectors. Some Micro-Pack 100W connector disassembly procedures will vary. Use this procedure as a guide. 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 6402 Page 2723 Remove all rust from the ground terminal, the cylinder head and the retaining nut or bolt. Position the main engine wiring harness ground terminal and install the nut or bolt. Tighten: Tighten the retaining nut or bolt to 16 N.m (12 lb ft). Apply some type of electrical moisture sealant to protect the harness terminal from further corrosion. Disclaimer Page 3295 9. The illustration shows a cutaway view of the connector to aid the technician in releasing the terminal retainer. 10. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Terminal Position Assurance Locks TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Tyco/Amp Connectors (CM 42-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (CM 42-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the connector body and pull the CPA out. The CPA is on the wire harness side of connector. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 7 Alarm Module: Diagrams Immobilizer Connector End Views Theft Deterrent Control Module (BAE) Page 2432 It is very important to use the correct test adapter when testing for proper terminal contact of fuses and relays in a bussed electrical center (BEC). Use J-35616-35 to test for proper terminal contact. Failure to use J-35616-35 can result in improper diagnosis of the BEC. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Separate the connector halves. 2. Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body. 3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J-38125 , test that the retention force is significantly different between a good terminal and a suspect terminal. Replace the female terminal in question. FLAT WIRE (DOCK AND LOCK) CONNECTORS There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock) connectors on the harness side or the component side. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Remove the component in question. 2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side of the connector as oil from your skin may be a source of contamination as well. 3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other imperfections that could cause poor terminal contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are uniform and free of damage or deformation. 4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the on the flat wire harness connector in order to test the circuit in question. CONTROL MODULE/COMPONENT VOLTAGE AND GROUNDS Poor voltage or ground connections can cause widely varying symptoms. Test all control module voltage supply circuits. Many vehicles have multiple circuits supplying voltage to a control module. Other components in the system may have separate voltage supply circuits that may also need to be tested. Inspect connections at the module/component connectors, fuses, and any intermediate connections between the voltage source and the module/component. A test lamp or a DMM may indicate that voltage is present, but neither tests the ability of the circuit to carry sufficient current. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Power Distribution Schematics. - Test all control module ground and system ground circuits. The control module may have multiple ground circuits. Other components in the system may have separate grounds that may also need to be tested. Inspect grounds for clean and tight connections at the grounding point. Inspect the connections at the component and in splice packs, where applicable. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Ground Distribution Schematics. TEMPERATURE SENSITIVITY - An intermittent condition may occur when a component/connection reaches normal operating temperature. The condition may occur only when the component/connection is cold, or only when the component/connection is hot. - Freeze Frame, Failure Records, Snapshot, or Vehicle Data Recorder data may help with this type of intermittent condition, where applicable. - If the intermittent is related to heat, review the data for a relationship with the following: High ambient temperatures - Underhood/engine generated heat - Circuit generated heat due to a poor connection, or high electrical load - Higher than normal load conditions, towing, etc. - If the intermittent is related to cold, review the data for the following: Low ambient temperatures-In extremely low temperatures, ice may form in a connection or component. Inspect for water intrusion. - The condition only occurs on a cold start. - The condition goes away when the vehicle warms up. - Information from the customer may help to determine if the trouble follows a pattern that is temperature related. - If temperature is suspected of causing an intermittent fault condition, attempt to duplicate the condition. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required. ELECTROMAGNETIC INTERFERENCE (EMI) AND ELECTRICAL NOISE Some electrical components/circuits are sensitive to electromagnetic interference (EMI) or other types of electrical noise. Inspect for the following conditions: A misrouted harness that is too close to high voltage/high current devices such as secondary ignition components, motors, generator etc-These components may induce electrical noise on a circuit that could interfere with normal circuit operation. - Electrical system interference caused by a malfunctioning relay, or a control module driven solenoid or switch-These conditions can cause a sharp electrical surge. Normally, the condition will occur when the malfunctioning component is operating. - Improper installation of non-factory or aftermarket add on accessories such as lights, 2-way radios, amplifiers, electric motors, remote starters, alarm systems, cell phones, etc-These accessories may lead to interference while in use, but do not fail when the accessories are not in use. - Test for an open diode across the A/C compressor clutch and for other open diodes. Some relays may contain a clamping diode. - The generator may be allowing AC noise into the electrical system. INCORRECT CONTROL MODULE - There are only a few situations where reprogramming a control module is appropriate: A new service control module is installed. Page 4110 7. Wrap electrical tape around the connection as shown. 8. Route the engine coolant heater cord and extension cord behind the alternator and adjacent to the engine coolant crossover pipe as shown. 9. Continue to route the extension cord to the exit location desired by the customer as shown. 10. Review the routing of the coolant heater cord and extension cord to verify that it does not touch any sharp edges that could damage it. 11. Secure the engine coolant heater cord and the extension cord with tie straps as needed. 12. Resecure any of the original clips that retained the engine coolant heater cord to the vehicle that were released to provide length. Part Information The extension cord may be obtained at any of the following outlets: - Lowes* - Home Depot* - Canada: Acklands-Grainger* (www.acklandsgrainger.com), Catalogue Part Number: CWRSJTOW3C14-10 USA: Cords should bear the UL symbol. Canada: Cords should bear the ULc symbol or CSA approval. *We believe these sources and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume any responsibility for the products or material from these firms or for any such items that may be available from other sources. Page 6574 View of typical connector. View of connector in released position. 1. Locate the assist lever at the back of the connector. Move the assist lever to the rear position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the dress cover. Page 9029 - Kostel - Molex - Sumitomo - Tyco/AMP - Yazaki Identifying the manufacturer of a connector is often difficult. When trying to determine the manufacturer of a connector, look for specific identifying marks that are unique to that connector supplier. Most of these identify marks are hard to find or see. Check the connector carefully and refer to the information below for pictures and descriptions of connector identification markings. - Most of AFLs connectors have EPC on their connector body. Some of the smaller connectors will not have any markings on them. - In some cases Bosch will actually be printed on the connector. If Bosch does not appear on the connector, look for the Bosch logo. The Bosch logo is a circle with a blunted arrow inside. This logo can appear anywhere on the connector and is often very small. Page 3947 3. Install the oil pan-to-rear cover bolts (1) until snug. Do not over tighten. 4. Rotate the crankshaft until 2 opposing flywheel bolt holes are parallel to the oil pan surface. Important: The tapered legs of the alignment tool must enter the rear cover oil seal bore. 5. Install J 41476 and bolts onto the rear of the crankshaft. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 6. Tighten J 41476 mounting bolts until snug. Do not overtighten. 1. Tighten the oil pan-to-rear cover bolts to 12 N.m (106 lb in). 2. Tighten the engine rear cover bolts to 30 N.m (22 lb ft). 7. Remove J 41476. 8. Install a NEW crankshaft rear oil seal. Refer to Crankshaft Rear Oil Seal Replacement. 9. Install the engine flywheel. Refer to Engine Flywheel Replacement. Page 3436 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the DuraSeal splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of a connector. CPAs are used in all SIR System connectors and also in some connectors of other systems. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals of a connection. TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE CLIPS IMPORTANT: When making a splice in an area that may be exposed to moisture use a crimp and seal splice sleeve instead of a Splice Clip. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. Page 265 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches, and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original. - The wires insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the possibility of fuel contact. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1). 5. Select the proper duraseal splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool. Refer to the Crimp and Seal Splice Table. 6. Place the duraseal splice sleeve in the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115) crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 7. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to hold the duraseal splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 8. Insert the wires into the duraseal splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel in order to prevent the wire from passing through the splice (3). 9. Close the handles of the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115), until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is applied to the splice sleeve. 10. Shrink the insulation around the splice. - Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. - Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Splicing Inline Harness Diodes SPLICING INLINE HARNESS DIODES Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure. 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode. 2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool. 5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode. Page 445 6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias. Reference the appropriate service manual wiring schematic to obtain the correct diode installation position. 7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for the soldering equipment. 8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed. 9. IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode attachment points with tape. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape. Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable SPLICING TWISTED OR SHIELDED CABLE Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable. 1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splice is made. 3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire. Staggering the splices by 65 mm (2.5 in) is recommended. 4. IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical contact with the drain wire. Re-assemble the cable. Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape. - Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1). - Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire. - Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape. Page 6150 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link). - The wire insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. 5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold them between thumb and forefinger. 7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place. - Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction. - Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip. 8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool closes.Ensure that no strands of wire are cut. 10. Crimp the splice on each end (2). Page 270 Page 7248 Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Crankshaft Position System Variation Learn Crankshaft Position System Variation Learn 1. Install a scan tool. 2. Monitor the engine control module (ECM) for DTCs with a scan tool. If other DTCs are set, except DTC P0315, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle in Vehicle DTC Information for the applicable DTC that set. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Descriptions 3. Select the crankshaft position (CKP) variation learn procedure with a scan tool. 4. The scan tool instructs you to perform the following: 1. Accelerate to wide open throttle (WOT). 2. Release throttle when fuel cut-off occurs. 3. Observe fuel cut-off for applicable engine. 4. Engine should not accelerate beyond calibrated RPM value. 5. Release throttle immediately if value is exceeded. 6. Block drive wheels. 7. Set parking brake. 8. DO NOT apply brake pedal. 9. Cycle ignition from OFF to ON. 10. Apply and hold brake pedal. 11. Start and idle engine. 12. Turn A/C OFF. 13. Vehicle must remain in Park or Neutral. 14. The scan tool monitors certain component signals to determine if all the conditions are met to continue with the procedure. The scan tool only displays the condition that inhibits the procedure. The scan tool monitors the following components: * CKP sensors activity-If there is a CKP sensor condition, refer to the applicable DTC that set. * Camshaft position (CMP) sensor activity-If there is a CMP sensor condition, refer to the applicable DTC that set. * Engine coolant temperature (ECT)-If the ECT is not warm enough, idle the engine until the engine coolant temperature reaches the correct temperature. 5. Enable the CKP system variation learn procedure with a scan tool. Important: While the learn procedure is in progress, release the throttle immediately when the engine starts to decelerate. The engine control is returned to the operator and the engine responds to throttle position after the learn procedure is complete. 6. Accelerate to WOT. 7. Release when the fuel cut-off occurs. 8. Test in progress 9. The scan tool displays Learn Status: Learned this ignition. If the scan tool indicates that DTC P0315 ran and passed, the CKP variation learn procedure is complete. If the scan tool indicates DTC P0315 failed or did not run, refer to DTC P0315. If any other DTCs set, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle in Vehicle DTC Information for the applicable DTC that set. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Descriptions See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/P Code Charts/P0315 10. Turn OFF the ignition for 30 seconds after the learn procedure is completed successfully. 11. The CKP system variation learn procedure is also required when the following service procedures have been performed, regardless of whether DTC P0315 is set: * A CKP sensor replacement * An engine replacement * A ECM replacement * A harmonic balancer replacement * A crankshaft replacement * Any engine repairs which disturb the CKP sensor relationship Page 7622 IMPORTANT: Ensure that the dress cover and connector body are both in the released position before reassembling. Failure to do so may cause damage to the connector and component. Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (0.64) BOSCH CONNECTORS (0.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While pressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock until the lever is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Pull the rubber boot that covers the wires back to expose the end of the connector dress cover. 4. Place the connector locking lever in the center of the connector. 5. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs that are on the wire end of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover and connector body and pry up. Page 3922 1. If re-using the old coolant heater, apply thread sealant GM P/N 12346004 (Canadian P/N 10953480), or equivalent to the threads. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Install the coolant heater to the engine block. Tighten the coolant heater to 50 N.m (37 lb ft). Notice: The heater cord must not touch the engine, hot pipes, manifold, or any moving parts. Route the cord to the left front of the engine compartment securing with tie straps as necessary to prevent damage. 3. Connect the coolant heater (1) electrical connector. 4. Lower the vehicle. 5. Fill the cooling system. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System (LL8) Draining and Filling Cooling System (LH6, LS2). Page 7776 - JST connectors have JST in small letters on their connectors, similar to that above. The location of the logo will vary with the connector size and style. - Kostel has an "LK" with a circle around it. These connector are usually used as a transmissions connection and are currently use on some Cadillac vehicles. Page 2463 TERMINAL REMOVAL Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors. 1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA) device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1). 3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 4. Gently pull the cable and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector. 5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal, refer to Terminal Repair. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3. Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector. REINSTALLING TERMINAL 1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly, refer to Wiring Repairs. 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3. Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) DELPHI CONNECTORS (WEATHER PACK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 4503 View of a typical Micro 64 connector. Depress the lock and pull the lever over and past the lock. Page 7498 - Most Molex connectors will have the Molex logo on the dresscover of the connector. In some cases the connectors may have MX followed by another letter. The third letter indicates where the connector was made. A connector with MXD is a Molex connector made in Detroit. Sumitomo has a unique symbol on their connector and possibly a part number. The symbol is similar to that of a diamond lying on its side, similar to that shown. The logo could appear anywhere but the most common place is at the wire side of the housing. Tyco/AMP has many different and unique connector designs. Some may or may not have identifiable marks on them. Page 4557 11. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 12. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 13. Center the high temperature SCT1 shrink tube over the DuraSeal splice sleeve. 14. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the high temperature heat shrink tubing. 15. Gradually move the heat from the center to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 16. Replace any reflective tape and clips that may have been remove during the repair. Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation REPAIRING DAMAGED WIRE INSULATION Wire Size Conversion Page 5883 If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the DuraSeal splice sleeves. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: - Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. - Do not use the crimp and DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 to crimp DuraSeal splice sleeve. In order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 4429 7. Pressing the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool in the release cavity of the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and crimper in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (DOOR MODULE) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Side view of connector. View of top of connector. 1. Locate the assist lever and lock on the top of the connector. Page 1464 The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors. 1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position. 4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool J 38125-10A (GM P/N 12014012-1) into the front (mating end) of the connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal through the back of the connector (2). IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector. 6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. 7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily. 10. Perform system check. Delphi Connectors (12 Way) DELPHI CONNECTORS (12-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. Page 7618 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (BSK) BOSCH CONNECTORS (BSK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 3. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 4. Insert the J 38125-561 tool into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 5. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is Page 2662 1 - Front Passenger Door 2 - Inflatable Restraint Side Impact Sensor (SIS) - Right 3 - Right Front Door Harness Electronic Frontal Sensors Page 4291 * The hose connections * The areas surrounding the connections Disconnect the CH-48027-2 (2) from the CH-48027-3 (4). 11. Disconnect the CH-48027-3 (4) from the fuel rail service port. 12. Remove the shop towel from around the fuel rail service port, and place in an approved gasoline container. 13. Install the fuel rail service port cap. 14. Install the engine cover, if required. 15. Tighten the fuel fill cap. Without CH-48027 Caution: Refer to Gasoline/Gasoline Vapors Caution. Caution: Remove the fuel tank cap and relieve the fuel system pressure before servicing the fuel system in order to reduce the risk of personal injury. After you relieve the fuel system pressure, a small amount of fuel may be released when servicing the fuel lines, the fuel injection pump, or the connections. In order to reduce the risk of personal injury, cover the fuel system components with a shop towel before disconnection. This will catch any fuel that may leak out. Place the towel in an approved container when the disconnection is complete. 1. Loosen the fuel fill cap in order to relieve the fuel tank vapor pressure. 2. Remove the engine cover, if required. 3. Remove the fuel rail service port cap. 4. Wrap a shop towel around the fuel rail service port and using a small flat bladed tool, depress (open) the fuel rail test port valve. 5. Remove the shop towel from around the fuel rail service port, and place in an approved gasoline container. 6. Install the fuel rail service port cap. 7. Install the engine cover, if required. 8. Tighten the fuel fill cap. Page 3996 Step 1 - Step 10 Page 8512 vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide variety of actions, including: - Wiggling the harness - Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting - Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector - Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation - Relocating a harness or wires All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. Another option is, with the component commanded ON and OFF by the scan tool, move related connectors and wiring and observe the component operation. With the engine running, move related connectors and wiring while monitoring engine operation. If harness or connector movement affects the data displayed, component/system operation, or engine operation, inspect and repair the harness/connections as necessary. You may need to load the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these cases you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide good results as well. There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions, along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the circuit to these kinds of conditions. SALT WATER SPRAY Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture. Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5 percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously. HIGH TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070. Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault condition. The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis. This option does not allow for the same control, however. LOW TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect. If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to -18°C (0°F) from one end and +71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized cooling needs. Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or components in an effort to duplicate the concern. DUPLICATING FAILURE CONDITIONS - If none of the previous tests are successful, attempt to duplicate and/or capture the failure conditions. Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, where applicable, contains the conditions that were present when the DTC set. 1. Review and record Freeze Frame/Failure Records data. 2. Clear the DTCs using the scan tool. 3. Turn the key to OFF and wait 15 seconds. 4. Operate the vehicle under the same conditions that were noted in Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, as closely as possible. The vehicle must also be operating within the Conditions for Running the DTC. Refer to Conditions for Running the DTC in the supporting text if a DTC is being diagnosed. 5. Monitor DTC Status for the DTC being tested. The scan tool will indicate Ran, when the enabling conditions have been satisfied long enough for the DTC to run. The scan tool will also indicate whether the DTC passed or failed. - An alternate method is to drive the vehicle with the DMM connected to a suspected circuit. An abnormal reading on the DMM when the concern occurs, may help you locate the concern. Measuring Frequency Page 4517 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the TPA. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the nose piece. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. Locations Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Locations Fuse Block - Underhood (5.3L/6.0L), Label Page 80 networks, and will not require an upgrade in connection with the cellular industry's transition to the digital network. In order to verify the type of OnStar(R) Hardware in a vehicle, type the VIN into the VIN look-up tool, which is available at the OnStar(R) Online Enrollment website within GM GlobalConnect (for U.S. dealers) or InfoNet (for Canadian dealers). Disclaimer Page 7133 Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Install the ECT sensor. Tighten the sensor to 20 N.m (15 lb ft). 3. Connect the ECT sensor electrical connector (1). 4. Refill the engine coolant. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System (LL8) Draining and Filling Cooling System (LH6, LS2). Page 4198 1. Clean the cylinder head valve spring seat and/or shim area. 2. Lubricate the valve guide and valve stem oil seal with clean engine oil. 3. Install the valve stem oil seal/shim assembly (1, 5). 4. Install the valve spring (4). 5. Install the valve spring cap (3). 6. Compress the valve spring using the J 38606. 7. Install the valve keys. 1. Use grease in order to hold the valve keys in place. 2. Make sure the keys seat properly in the groove of the valve stem. 3. Carefully release the valve spring pressure, making sure the valve keys stay in place. 4. Remove J 38606. 5. Tap the end of the valve stem with a plastic faced hammer to seat the keys (if necessary). 8. Remove J 22794 from the spark plug port. Page 2689 Seat Position Sensor: Service and Repair Inflatable Restraint Seat Position Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Remove the seat from the vehicle. 2. Unclip the front, rear, and side J-strips (1, 2) on the underside of the seat. 3. Remove the lumbar knob by pulling the knob straight away from the seat, if equipped. 4. Remove the recliner handle. 5. Remove the screws (2) that retain the lumbar adjustment mechanism (1) to the seat adjuster. 6. Remove the lumbar cable from the lumbar adjustment mechanism. Page 1654 5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape. Seat Belt Schematic Icons Seat Belt Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons Page 4467 Page 5774 Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Diagrams Engine Controls Connector End Views Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor Page 1851 View of connector in released position. 4. Disconnect the connector from the component. 5. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Release the rear lower half of the wiredress cover. Page 6432 5. Insert the J 38125-557 (GM P/N 12122378) into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 6. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Connector Position Assurance Locks CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of the connector. CPAs are used in various connectors throughout the vehicle. CPAs are also used in all SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals, of the connector. Connector Repairs CONNECTOR REPAIRS Page 6813 Important The M6 conductive rivet stud as shown, can accommodate a panel thickness range of 0.7-4.2 mm (0.03-0.17 in). If there are layers of sheet metal, they should be touching without any air gaps to ensure a good ground. 5. Select a M6 conductive rivet stud. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. Note Use the GE-50317 rivet stud tool kit. 6. Place the M6 conductive rivet stud (1) in the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole. Assemble the rivet stud tool (2) with the groove and flare side facing the rivet stud, then the washer and the M6 nut (3). 7. Using a wrench on the rivet stud tool, and a socket on the M6 nut, secure the M6 conductive rivet stud. 8. Ensure the rivet stud is securely fastened, WITHOUT ANY detectable movement. 9. Completely wrap the threads of the rivet stud with painters tape or equivalent. Note The rivet stud and surrounding panel area MUST BE properly refinished PRIOR to the installation of the ground wire terminal and conductive nut to maintain a secure, stable and corrosion-free electrical ground. 10. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and Repair in SI. 11. Allow the refinished repair area to cure sufficiently before removing the protective material applied to the rivet stud threads. 12. Remove the painters tape or equivalent from the rivet stud threads. 13. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, thoroughly clean the rivet stud threads to remove any adhesive and allow to dry. 14. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M6 conductive rivet stud. Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase. Page 5229 If a wire is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm, etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except coaxial. - Do not use the DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent American wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 5854 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry one side of the nose piece up to the pre-stage position. When the nose piece is in the pre-staged position, the nose piece will be raised above the connector body the length of the step in the nose piece. 7. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry the other side of the piece to the pre-stage position. If the nose piece is higher than the first step in the nose piece, gently push down on the nose piece until it meets with resistance from the connector body, you should feel the nose piece click into position. Page 4946 5. Once the nose piece retainers are relaxed, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should raise slightly. 6. On the opposite side of the nose piece, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should release completely. If the nose piece does not come off, repeat the procedure on the opposite side. Memory Seat Module - Driver C1 Memory Seat Module - Driver C1 (w/Memory) Page 5689 - Most Molex connectors will have the Molex logo on the dresscover of the connector. In some cases the connectors may have MX followed by another letter. The third letter indicates where the connector was made. A connector with MXD is a Molex connector made in Detroit. Sumitomo has a unique symbol on their connector and possibly a part number. The symbol is similar to that of a diamond lying on its side, similar to that shown. The logo could appear anywhere but the most common place is at the wire side of the housing. Tyco/AMP has many different and unique connector designs. Some may or may not have identifiable marks on them. Page 7809 3. Remove the dress cover by using a flat-blade tool to release the connector locking tabs and pulling off the dress cover. 4. Relieve the tension on the nose piece retainers by inserting J-38125-12A (12094429) into the single retainer slot on the end of the nose piece and gently prying out the locking tab. Repeat the process for both of the nose piece locking tabs on the opposite side of the nose piece. Page 7801 View of typical connector. View of connector in released position. 1. Locate the assist lever at the back of the connector. Move the assist lever to the rear position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the dress cover. Page 5927 Locations Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Locations Fuse Block - Underhood (5.3L/6.0L), Label Page 4421 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry one side of the nose piece up to the pre-stage position. When the nose piece is in the pre-staged position, the nose piece will be raised above the connector body the length of the step in the nose piece. 7. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry the other side of the piece to the pre-stage position. If the nose piece is higher than the first step in the nose piece, gently push down on the nose piece until it meets with resistance from the connector body, you should feel the nose piece click into position. Page 8585 2. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully push the terminal position assurance (TPA) towards the face of the connector on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA is fragile and may break if not done carefully. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. 3. Use the J 38125-215 tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 7773 Connector Anatomy Connector Repairs contains a list of all connector repairs. The connector repairs are listed by the connector manufacturer and then by connector type. If the technician cannot identify the manufacturer of the connector, refer to Identifying Connectors below. Knowing the connector manufacturer will assist in finding the correct connector repair from the following list: - Connector Position Assurance Locks - Terminal Position Assurance Locks - Bosch Connectors (0.64) Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) Bosch Connectors (BSK) Bosch Connectors (ECM) - Delphi Connectors (Micro.64) Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) Delphi Connectors (12-Way) - Tyco/AMP Connectors (CM 42-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) Tyco/AMP Connectors (025 Cap) Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) - Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) - Repairing Connector Terminals IDENTIFYING CONNECTORS Knowing the connector manufacturer is helpful when trying to locating the correct connector repair procedure. There are many different connector designs used on GM vehicles and it is sometimes difficult to identify the connector manufacturer. The information in this document should help with the identification of connector manufactures. The following connector manufacturers make most of the connectors found in GM vehicles: AFL/EPC (Alcoa Fujikura Ltd./Engineered Plastics Components) - Bosch - Delphi - FCI (Framatome Connectors International) - JAE (Japan Aviation Electronics) - JST (Japan Solderless Terminals) Page 860 REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. The release tab is located on the top of the wiredress cover. View of connector in released position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Page 8317 Open the harness by removing any tape. 2. Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. 3. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 4. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent american wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 5. Slide a section of high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing down the length of wire to be spliced. Ensure that the shrink tubing will not interfere with the splice procedure. 6. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 7. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. 8. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 9. Insert the wire into the DuraSeal splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 10. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Page 5868 5. While pushing the terminal forward, insert the J 38125-24 in the release cavity above the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (43-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Page 2133 4. Use a small flat-blade tool to slide the terminal position assurance (TPA) up one notch on both ends of the connector. The TPA is located underneath the wire dress cover. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 8716 6. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by pressing on the tang. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (SENSOR) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) tool into the cavity on the lower right hand face of the connector until the terminal release tang access panel slides over. Page 5692 View of the connector when released from the component. View of another type of Micro 64 connector. Page 6865 Page 4359 Page 9014 - A control module from another vehicle is installed. - Revised software/calibration files have been released for this vehicle. - IMPORTANT: DO NOT re-program the control module with the SAME software/calibration files that are already present in the control module. This is not an effective repair for any type of concern. Verify that the control module contains the correct software/calibration. If incorrect programming is found, reprogram the control module with the most current software/calibration. Refer to Control Module References for replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Testing for Short to Ground TESTING FOR SHORT TO GROUND NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 4. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit. With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is a short to ground in the circuit. Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2. Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). - When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. - If the DMM does not display voltage 4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is shorted. Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A DIGITAL MULTIMETER NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the powertrain control module (PCM), should only be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200 Digital Multimeter (DMM). The J 39200 instruction manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminage even though voltage is present. The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity. IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading. Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the measurement. Page 6104 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) and slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. Page 6541 5. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove TPA from the connector. 6. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Page 2071 Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Install the 3 APP sensor bolts (1). Tighten the bolts to 20 N.m (15 lb ft). 3. Connect the APP sensor electrical connector. 4. Verify that the vehicle meets the following conditions: * The vehicle is not in a reduced engine power mode. * The ignition is ON. * The engine is OFF. 5. Connect a scan tool in order to test for a proper throttle-opening and throttle-closing range. 6. Operate the accelerator pedal and monitor the throttle angles. The accelerator pedal should operate freely, without binding, between a closed throttle, and a wide open throttle. Page 5807 - A control module from another vehicle is installed. - Revised software/calibration files have been released for this vehicle. - IMPORTANT: DO NOT re-program the control module with the SAME software/calibration files that are already present in the control module. This is not an effective repair for any type of concern. Verify that the control module contains the correct software/calibration. If incorrect programming is found, reprogram the control module with the most current software/calibration. Refer to Control Module References for replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Testing for Short to Ground TESTING FOR SHORT TO GROUND NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 4. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit. With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is a short to ground in the circuit. Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2. Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). - When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. - If the DMM does not display voltage 4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is shorted. Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A DIGITAL MULTIMETER NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the powertrain control module (PCM), should only be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200 Digital Multimeter (DMM). The J 39200 instruction manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminage even though voltage is present. The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity. IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading. Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the measurement. Page 2264 7. Pressing the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool in the release cavity of the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and crimper in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (DOOR MODULE) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Side view of connector. View of top of connector. 1. Locate the assist lever and lock on the top of the connector. Page 7625 5. Insert the J 38125-557 (GM P/N 12122378) into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 6. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Connector Position Assurance Locks CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of the connector. CPAs are used in various connectors throughout the vehicle. CPAs are also used in all SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals, of the connector. Connector Repairs CONNECTOR REPAIRS Page 5343 8. Insert the J 38125-213 into the small terminal release hole on the nose piece and gently pull on the back of the wire. 9. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Repairing Connector Terminals REPAIRING CONNECTOR TERMINALS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following: Push to Seat terminals - Pull to Seat terminals Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your terminal repair. The J-38125 contains further information. 1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.For cable seal terminals, remove the seal. 2. Apply the correct cable seal per gage size of the wire, if used.Slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation removal. 3. Remove the insulation. 4. For sealed terminals only, align the seal with the end of the cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal.For sealed terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal. 6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.For sealed terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable. 8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals excepting Micro-Pack 100.64 size. Soldering Micro-Pack 100 World terminals may damage the terminal. Sumitomo Connectors SUMITOMO CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 5998 7. The illustration above identifies the entry canal where the terminal release tool will be inserted, and the terminal cavity. - Terminal (1) - Entry Canal (2) 8. Insert the J-38125-553 (15315247) tool into the entry canal and pry up on the terminal retainer. The terminal retainer is a small plastic piece on the top of the terminal. The terminal retainer must be held up while the terminal is pulled out of the connector. Page 5142 Page 1510 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the DuraSeal splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of a connector. CPAs are used in all SIR System connectors and also in some connectors of other systems. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals of a connection. TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE CLIPS IMPORTANT: When making a splice in an area that may be exposed to moisture use a crimp and seal splice sleeve instead of a Splice Clip. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. Page 398 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the TPA. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the nose piece. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. Page 4647 3. Use a small flat-bladed tool to gently pry off the dress cover by inserting the tool under the cover opposite the harness side and prying up. 4. Remove the cover. 5. Using a small flat-bladed tool, push on the side of the nose piece retainer while pushing the nose piece forward with your thumb. This will release the terminal position assurance (TPA). 6. Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) into the corresponding terminal release cavity. The release cavities are the 2 center rows of cavities on one half of the connector. Page 4992 under pressure if the radiator cap or the surge tank cap is removed while the engine and radiator are still hot. 4. Remove the surge tank fill cap from the surge tank or the coolant pressure cap from the radiator. 5. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle in SI. 6. Place a clean drain pan under the radiator drain cock or under the lower radiator hose depending on the vehicle. Refer to Cooling System Draining and Filling in SI. 7. Loosen the radiator drain cock if equipped or use J 38185 clamp pliers and reposition the clamp on the lower radiator hose at the radiator. 8. Remove the end of the lower radiator hose from the radiator. 9. Drain the engine coolant sufficiently below the level of the ECT sensor. 10. Close the radiator drain cock or connect the lower radiator hose at the radiator. 11. Use the J 38185 clamp pliers to place the clamp into the original position on the hose. 12. Lower the vehicle. 13. Disconnect the wiring harness connector from the ECT sensor (2). 14. Remove the ECT sensor (1) from the front of the cylinder head. 15. Remove the corresponding size plug at the rear of the OTHER cylinder head. 16. Coat the threads of the ECT sensor with sealer. Use GM P/N 12346004 (Canadian P/N 10953480) or an equivalent. 17. Install the ECT sensor in the hole of the cylinder head where the plug was removed. Tighten Tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb ft). 18. Coat the threads of the plug with sealer. Use GM P/N 12346004 (Canadian P/N 10953480) or an equivalent. 19. Install the plug in the hole of the cylinder head where the ECT sensor was removed Tighten Tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb ft). Important Leave enough wire attached to the ECT sensor harness connector in order to create manageable splices that are at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splice. Page 7677 6. Gently pry the plastic terminal retainer down and carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (16-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, pull the two connector halves apart. Page 2442 5. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove TPA from the connector. 6. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Page 3778 3. Use a small flat-bladed tool to gently pry off the dress cover by inserting the tool under the cover opposite the harness side and prying up. 4. Remove the cover. 5. Using a small flat-bladed tool, push on the side of the nose piece retainer while pushing the nose piece forward with your thumb. This will release the terminal position assurance (TPA). 6. Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) into the corresponding terminal release cavity. The release cavities are the 2 center rows of cavities on one half of the connector. Page 4831 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. 4. Remove the dress cover by using a flat bladed tool to release the dress cover locking tabs and lift up on the dress cover. 5. Cut the tie wrap that holds the wires to the connector body. Page 2378 6. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by pressing on the tang. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (SENSOR) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) tool into the cavity on the lower right hand face of the connector until the terminal release tang access panel slides over. Page 8520 Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested: - Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. - Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a component or to other harnesses. - If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A TEST LAMP TOOLS REQUIRED J 35616-200 Test Light - Probe Kit NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminate even though voltage is present. The J 35616-200 is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair of leads. To properly operate this tool use the following procedures. When testing for voltage: 1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested. When testing for ground: 1. Attach one lead to battery positive voltage. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where ground should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is ground at the point being tested. Using Connector Test Adapters USING CONNECTOR TEST ADAPTERS NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Using Fused Jumper Wires USING FUSED JUMPER WIRES TOOLS REQUIRED J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged. The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested. AFL/ECP Connectors AFL/EPC CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 1758 3. Remove the dress cover by using a flat-blade tool to release the connector locking tabs and pulling off the dress cover. 4. Relieve the tension on the nose piece retainers by inserting J-38125-12A (12094429) into the single retainer slot on the end of the nose piece and gently prying out the locking tab. Repeat the process for both of the nose piece locking tabs on the opposite side of the nose piece. Page 3793 Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size. REPAIRING A FUSIBLE LINK IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient overload protection. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. Flat Wire Repairs FLAT WIRE REPAIRS NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced. GMLAN Wiring Repairs GMLAN WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The GM Local Area Network (GMLAN) System requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working on GMLAN connectors and terminals. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items in order to repair the GMLAN wiring: Dura Seal splice sleeves - A wire stripping tool - J 38125-8 Crimping Tool (GM P/N 12085115) - J 38125-5 Ultra Torch Special Tool (GM P/N 12085116) The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. - A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors GMLAN REPAIRS IMPORTANT: When making a repair to any GMLAN network, the original wire length after the repair must be the same length as before the repair. If the network is a twisted pair, the twist must be maintained after the repair is completed. GMLAN has 2 types of networks, low speed and high speed. Low speed GMLAN has a single wire and works at slow speeds. High speed GMLAN has 2 wires in a twisted pair and works at higher speeds. For more information on GMLAN, refer to Data Link Communications Description and Operation. GMLAN CONNECTOR TERMINAL REPAIR IMPORTANT: A service terminal can be used to replace damaged connector terminals for both high speed and low speed GMLAN systems. When making a connector terminal repair on a GMLAN high speed system with twisted pair wires, do not untwist the wires more than necessary to make the repair. The terminals in the GMLAN system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are available in the J-38125. If the individual terminals are damaged on any GMLAN connection, use the appropriate connector repair procedure in order to repair the terminal. GMLAN WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 7130 Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Locations Engine Controls Component Views Left Side of Engine - Front 1 - Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor 2 - G108 Page 6428 5. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove TPA from the connector. 6. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Page 4797 11. Insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) into the 2 triangular cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 12. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE 1. Prior to installation the terminal must be aligned so the (1) coding lugs align with the (2) coding grooves on the connector. 2. Once the terminal is aligned, slide the terminal into the cavity until the retainer has engaged in the cavity of the connector. 3. Slide the TPA in the connector body and seat it using a small flat bladed tool. The TPA is seated when it is flush with the contact housing. 4. Secure the wires to the connector body using a tie wrap and replace the dress cover and grommet. Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) BOSCH CONNECTORS (2.8 JPT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Pull out the slider on the connector position assurance (CPA) until it is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 8065 Open the harness by removing any tape. 2. Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. 3. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 4. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent american wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 5. Slide a section of high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing down the length of wire to be spliced. Ensure that the shrink tubing will not interfere with the splice procedure. 6. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 7. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. 8. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 9. Insert the wire into the DuraSeal splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 10. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Page 1553 Page 131 Built After and Including the VIN Breakpoints shown. The Generation (Gen) 6.1 OnStar(R) system found in these vehicles has the capability to change the default English voice recognition to French or Spanish. Changing the language of the OnStar(R) system will change the following features to the language you select: Voice recognition command prompts will be played in the language selected. The voice recognition system will only recognize commands given in the selected language. Once completed, this process completely changes all voice recognition and voice commands of the OnStar(R) system. The process will need to be repeated in its entirety to change to a different language, including English. Page 6390 5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape. Seat Belt Schematic Icons Seat Belt Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons Page 1840 vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide variety of actions, including: - Wiggling the harness - Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting - Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector - Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation - Relocating a harness or wires All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. Another option is, with the component commanded ON and OFF by the scan tool, move related connectors and wiring and observe the component operation. With the engine running, move related connectors and wiring while monitoring engine operation. If harness or connector movement affects the data displayed, component/system operation, or engine operation, inspect and repair the harness/connections as necessary. You may need to load the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these cases you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide good results as well. There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions, along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the circuit to these kinds of conditions. SALT WATER SPRAY Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture. Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5 percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously. HIGH TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070. Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault condition. The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis. This option does not allow for the same control, however. LOW TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect. If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to -18°C (0°F) from one end and +71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized cooling needs. Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or components in an effort to duplicate the concern. DUPLICATING FAILURE CONDITIONS - If none of the previous tests are successful, attempt to duplicate and/or capture the failure conditions. Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, where applicable, contains the conditions that were present when the DTC set. 1. Review and record Freeze Frame/Failure Records data. 2. Clear the DTCs using the scan tool. 3. Turn the key to OFF and wait 15 seconds. 4. Operate the vehicle under the same conditions that were noted in Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, as closely as possible. The vehicle must also be operating within the Conditions for Running the DTC. Refer to Conditions for Running the DTC in the supporting text if a DTC is being diagnosed. 5. Monitor DTC Status for the DTC being tested. The scan tool will indicate Ran, when the enabling conditions have been satisfied long enough for the DTC to run. The scan tool will also indicate whether the DTC passed or failed. - An alternate method is to drive the vehicle with the DMM connected to a suspected circuit. An abnormal reading on the DMM when the concern occurs, may help you locate the concern. Measuring Frequency Page 5362 View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. 4. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers CIRCUIT PROTECTION - CIRCUIT BREAKERS A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types of circuit Page 5344 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 8253 5. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove TPA from the connector. 6. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Page 4487 View of connector in released position. 4. Disconnect the connector from the component. 5. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Release the rear lower half of the wiredress cover. Page 6880 If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200 DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J 39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected. IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J 39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and maximum (MAX) values measured. 1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of a suspected circuit to the other. 2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J 39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep). IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value in order to record the full change. 5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling the connections or the wiring, test driving, or performing other operations. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions. 6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9. Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist. Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections TESTING FOR INTERMITTENT CONDITIONS AND POOR CONNECTIONS TOOLS REQUIRED - J 35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit - J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit When the condition is not currently present, but is indicated in DTC history, the cause may be intermittent. An intermittent may also be the cause when there is a customer complaint, but the symptom cannot be duplicated. Refer to the Symptom Table of the system that is suspect of causing the condition before trying to locate an intermittent condition. Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the following items: Wiring broken inside the insulation - Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector - Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself, and corrosion in the wire to terminal contact area, etc. - Pierced or damaged insulation can allow moisture to enter the wiring causing corrosion. The conductor can corrode inside the insulation, with little visible evidence. Look for swollen and stiff sections of wire in the suspect circuits. - Wiring which has been pinched, cut, or its insulation rubbed through may cause an intermittent open or short as the bare area touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle. - Wiring that comes in contact with hot or exhaust components - Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required, in order to verify the customer concern. - Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. - Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis and Vehicle Data Recorder operation. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any inline connectors before replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation. Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination, usually in the underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit. Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper adapter. Always use the J 35616 when probing connectors. Other causes of terminal deformation are improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT IN BUSSED ELECTRICAL CENTERS (BEC) Page 8158 pulling it through. This will prevent damage to the internal seals of the connector. Once the terminal is pushed out of the connector, cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible and pull the wire through the connector. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE The Micro-Pack 100W connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool was developed to crimp Micro-Pack 100W terminals. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 2. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert the terminal into the crimp tool until the core wings are flush with the anvil on the crimp tool. Be sure that the wings are pointed toward the crimp tool former and release the spring locator. The locator will hold the terminal in place. Inspect the alignment of the terminal wings with the crimp tool former. If the terminal wings are wider than the crimp tool former, remove the terminal and bend the terminal wings in slightly. 5. Place stripped wire into terminal. 6. Crimp the new terminal to the wire. If a jam occurs, press the emergency release to open applicator. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire perform the following procedure in order to replace Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. Page 2056 US English/Metric Conversion US English/Metric Conversion Page 5586 3. Use a small flat-bladed tool to gently pry off the dress cover by inserting the tool under the cover opposite the harness side and prying up. 4. Remove the cover. 5. Using a small flat-bladed tool, push on the side of the nose piece retainer while pushing the nose piece forward with your thumb. This will release the terminal position assurance (TPA). 6. Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) into the corresponding terminal release cavity. The release cavities are the 2 center rows of cavities on one half of the connector. Page 3552 5. Position the wheel and tire so the valve stem is situated at the 2 o'clock position relative to the head. The tire iron or pry bar can be inserted when prying the outer tire bead up and over the mounting/dismounting head. 6. Position the wheel and tire so that the valve stem is situated again at the 2 o'clock position relative to the head. The tire iron or pry bar can be inserted when prying the inner tire bead up and over the mounting/dismounting head. 7. Remove all residual liquid sealant from the inside of the tire and wheel surfaces. If any tire sealant is noted upon tire dismounting on vehicles equipped with TPM replace the tire pressure sensor. 8. Use a wire brush or coarse steel wool in order to remove any rubber, light rust or corrosion from the wheel bead seats. Important: If bead seat corrosion has been identified as an air loss concern on the wheel being worked on, refer to GM Service Bulletin # 08-03-10-006 for additional information on correcting the leak. 9. Apply GM P/N 12345884 (in Canada, P/N 5728223) or equivalent to the tire bead and the wheel rim. Page 1397 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link). - The wire insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. 5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold them between thumb and forefinger. 7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place. - Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction. - Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip. 8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool closes.Ensure that no strands of wire are cut. 10. Crimp the splice on each end (2). Page 3791 View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. 4. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers CIRCUIT PROTECTION - CIRCUIT BREAKERS A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types of circuit Page 2870 1. Relieve the fuel system pressure, if required. Perform the following steps: Caution: Wrap a shop towel around the fuel pressure connection in order to reduce the risk of fire and personal injury. The towel will absorb any fuel leakage that occurs during the connection of the fuel pressure gage. Place the towel in an approved container when the connection of the fuel pressure gage is complete. 1. Wrap a shop towel around the fuel rail service port. 2. Place the hose on the CH-48027-2 (2) into an approved gasoline container. 3. Open the valve on the CH-48027-2 (2) in order to bleed any fuel from the fuel rail. 4. Close the valve on the CH-48027-2 (2). 5. Remove the hose on the CH-48027-2 (2) from the approved gasoline container. 6. Remove the shop towel from around the fuel rail service port, and place in an approved gasoline container. Notice: Clean all of the following areas before performing any disconnections in order to avoid possible contamination in the system: * The fuel pipe connections * The hose connections * The areas surrounding the connections Disconnect the CH-48027-1 (1) from the CH-48027-2 (2). 2. Disconnect the CH-48027-2 (2) from the CH-48027-3 (4). 3. Disconnect the CH-48027-3 (4) from the fuel rail service port. 4. Install the fuel rail service port cap. 5. Tighten the fuel fill cap. Locations Seat Position Sensor: Locations SIR Component Views Under Driver Seat 1 - Seat Recline Motor - Driver (AR9) 2 - Seat Position Sensor - Recline (w/Memory) 3 - Inflatable Restraint Seat Position Sensor (SPS) - Left 4 - Seat Position Sensor - Horizontal (w/Memory) 5 Seat Horizontal Motor - Driver (AR9) 6 - Seat Position Sensor - Front (w/Memory) 7 - Seat Front Vertical Motor - Driver (AR9) 8 - Seat Rear Vertical Motor - Driver (AR9) 9 - Seat Position Sensor Rear (w/Memory) Under Passenger Seat Page 6289 Page 1770 Release the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the blue locking tabs on both ends of the connector. Gently slide the TPA up to the released position on both ends. 6. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-13A (GM P/N 12031876-1) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. Page 4962 View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. 4. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers CIRCUIT PROTECTION - CIRCUIT BREAKERS A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types of circuit Page 7749 Page 4865 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches, and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original. - The wires insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the possibility of fuel contact. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1). 5. Select the proper duraseal splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool. Refer to the Crimp and Seal Splice Table. 6. Place the duraseal splice sleeve in the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115) crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 7. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to hold the duraseal splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 8. Insert the wires into the duraseal splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel in order to prevent the wire from passing through the splice (3). 9. Close the handles of the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115), until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is applied to the splice sleeve. 10. Shrink the insulation around the splice. - Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. - Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Splicing Inline Harness Diodes SPLICING INLINE HARNESS DIODES Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure. 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode. 2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool. 5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode. Page 7491 6. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs located on the opposite side of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover at the connector end and pry up. 7. Remove the dress cover. 8. Cut the tie wrap on the wire bundle. 9. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting a small flat-bladed tool into the small slot in the end of the slider and pushing on the TPA until it comes out of the connector. When the TPA exits the opposite side of the connector, gasp the TPA and pull it completely out of the connector. 10. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 2265 2. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 843 - Yazaki has a wedge or arrow shape, similar to that shown. Delphi Connectors (Micro .64) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro 64 connectors. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. The lever lock may be located on the top or sides of the wire dress cover. Page 5244 Page 8020 pulling it through. This will prevent damage to the internal seals of the connector. Once the terminal is pushed out of the connector, cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible and pull the wire through the connector. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE The Micro-Pack 100W connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool was developed to crimp Micro-Pack 100W terminals. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 2. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert the terminal into the crimp tool until the core wings are flush with the anvil on the crimp tool. Be sure that the wings are pointed toward the crimp tool former and release the spring locator. The locator will hold the terminal in place. Inspect the alignment of the terminal wings with the crimp tool former. If the terminal wings are wider than the crimp tool former, remove the terminal and bend the terminal wings in slightly. 5. Place stripped wire into terminal. 6. Crimp the new terminal to the wire. If a jam occurs, press the emergency release to open applicator. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire perform the following procedure in order to replace Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. Page 5960 Connector Anatomy Connector Repairs contains a list of all connector repairs. The connector repairs are listed by the connector manufacturer and then by connector type. If the technician cannot identify the manufacturer of the connector, refer to Identifying Connectors below. Knowing the connector manufacturer will assist in finding the correct connector repair from the following list: - Connector Position Assurance Locks - Terminal Position Assurance Locks - Bosch Connectors (0.64) Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) Bosch Connectors (BSK) Bosch Connectors (ECM) - Delphi Connectors (Micro.64) Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) Delphi Connectors (12-Way) - Tyco/AMP Connectors (CM 42-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) Tyco/AMP Connectors (025 Cap) Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) - Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) - Repairing Connector Terminals IDENTIFYING CONNECTORS Knowing the connector manufacturer is helpful when trying to locating the correct connector repair procedure. There are many different connector designs used on GM vehicles and it is sometimes difficult to identify the connector manufacturer. The information in this document should help with the identification of connector manufactures. The following connector manufacturers make most of the connectors found in GM vehicles: AFL/EPC (Alcoa Fujikura Ltd./Engineered Plastics Components) - Bosch - Delphi - FCI (Framatome Connectors International) - JAE (Japan Aviation Electronics) - JST (Japan Solderless Terminals) Page 2756 13. Use the tire changer in order to install the tire to the wheel. Caution: To avoid serious personal injury, do not stand over tire when inflating. The bead may break when the bead snaps over the safety hump. Do not exceed 275 kPa (40 psi) pressure when inflating any tire if beads are not seated. If 275 kPa (40 psi) pressure will not seat the beads, deflate, lubricate the beads and reinflate. Overinflating may cause the bead to break and cause serious personal injury. Important: Allowable bead seating pressure is 345 kPa (50 psi) on Extended Mobility Tires. 14. Inflate the tire until it passes the bead humps. Be sure that the valve core is not installed at this time. 15. Install the valve core to the valve core stem. 16. Inflate the tire to the proper air pressure. 17. Ensure that the locating rings are visible on both sides of the tire in order to verify that the tire bead is fully seated on the wheel. Parts Information The product shown above is available from GM SPO. Disclaimer Page 1719 6. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs located on the opposite side of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover at the connector end and pry up. 7. Remove the dress cover. 8. Cut the tie wrap on the wire bundle. 9. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting a small flat-bladed tool into the small slot in the end of the slider and pushing on the TPA until it comes out of the connector. When the TPA exits the opposite side of the connector, gasp the TPA and pull it completely out of the connector. 10. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 2390 If a wire is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm, etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except coaxial. - Do not use the DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent American wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 5104 Note All pictures must be sent as a.jpg file. 27. E-mail a copy of the screenshot to [email protected]. In the subject line of the e-mail include the phrase "V8 Cal" as well as the complete VIN and Dealer BAC. In the body of the e-mail, include the VIN, mileage, R.O. number and BAC. Include a brief description of the customer concern and cause of the concern. Note The dealer will receive an e-mail reply after the calibrations have been validated. The e-mail reply will advise the dealer if the calibrations are OEM. 28. Allow two hours for the PQC to verify the calibrations and set up the case details. ‹› If the PQC determines that the calibrations ARE aftermarket calibrations, DO NOT contact GM Technical Assistance to discuss warranty concerns on the aftermarket calibrations. ALL questions and concerns about warranty should be directed to the dealers Fixed Operations Manager (FOM), (Warranty Manager (WM) in Canada). 29. You may call the PQC two hours after submitting the e-mail for authorization to replace the assembly. This will provide them time to receive, review and set up a case on the request. Please be prepared to provide all the usual documentation that is normally required when requesting an assembly authorization from the PQC. Warranty Information - The Dealership Service Management must be involved in any situation that would justify the use of labor operation Z1111. - Notify the Fixed Operations Manager (FOM) (Warranty Manager (WM) in Canada) of the situation. - All claims will have to be routed to the FOM (WM in Canada) for approval. - Please refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 09-00-89-016, Labor Operation Z1111 - Suspected Tampering or Vehicle Modifications for important information. For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 5855 8. Insert the J 38125-213 into the small terminal release hole on the nose piece and gently pull on the back of the wire. 9. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Repairing Connector Terminals REPAIRING CONNECTOR TERMINALS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following: Push to Seat terminals - Pull to Seat terminals Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your terminal repair. The J-38125 contains further information. 1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.For cable seal terminals, remove the seal. 2. Apply the correct cable seal per gage size of the wire, if used.Slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation removal. 3. Remove the insulation. 4. For sealed terminals only, align the seal with the end of the cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal.For sealed terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal. 6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.For sealed terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable. 8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals excepting Micro-Pack 100.64 size. Soldering Micro-Pack 100 World terminals may damage the terminal. Sumitomo Connectors SUMITOMO CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 1352 Release the lower wiredress cover locking tab. Release the upper wiredress cover locking tab. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. Page 689 Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested: - Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. - Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a component or to other harnesses. - If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A TEST LAMP TOOLS REQUIRED J 35616-200 Test Light - Probe Kit NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminate even though voltage is present. The J 35616-200 is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair of leads. To properly operate this tool use the following procedures. When testing for voltage: 1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested. When testing for ground: 1. Attach one lead to battery positive voltage. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where ground should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is ground at the point being tested. Using Connector Test Adapters USING CONNECTOR TEST ADAPTERS NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Using Fused Jumper Wires USING FUSED JUMPER WIRES TOOLS REQUIRED J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged. The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested. AFL/ECP Connectors AFL/EPC CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 4784 It is very important to use the correct test adapter when testing for proper terminal contact of fuses and relays in a bussed electrical center (BEC). Use J-35616-35 to test for proper terminal contact. Failure to use J-35616-35 can result in improper diagnosis of the BEC. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Separate the connector halves. 2. Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body. 3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J-38125 , test that the retention force is significantly different between a good terminal and a suspect terminal. Replace the female terminal in question. FLAT WIRE (DOCK AND LOCK) CONNECTORS There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock) connectors on the harness side or the component side. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Remove the component in question. 2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side of the connector as oil from your skin may be a source of contamination as well. 3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other imperfections that could cause poor terminal contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are uniform and free of damage or deformation. 4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the on the flat wire harness connector in order to test the circuit in question. CONTROL MODULE/COMPONENT VOLTAGE AND GROUNDS Poor voltage or ground connections can cause widely varying symptoms. Test all control module voltage supply circuits. Many vehicles have multiple circuits supplying voltage to a control module. Other components in the system may have separate voltage supply circuits that may also need to be tested. Inspect connections at the module/component connectors, fuses, and any intermediate connections between the voltage source and the module/component. A test lamp or a DMM may indicate that voltage is present, but neither tests the ability of the circuit to carry sufficient current. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Power Distribution Schematics. - Test all control module ground and system ground circuits. The control module may have multiple ground circuits. Other components in the system may have separate grounds that may also need to be tested. Inspect grounds for clean and tight connections at the grounding point. Inspect the connections at the component and in splice packs, where applicable. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Ground Distribution Schematics. TEMPERATURE SENSITIVITY - An intermittent condition may occur when a component/connection reaches normal operating temperature. The condition may occur only when the component/connection is cold, or only when the component/connection is hot. - Freeze Frame, Failure Records, Snapshot, or Vehicle Data Recorder data may help with this type of intermittent condition, where applicable. - If the intermittent is related to heat, review the data for a relationship with the following: High ambient temperatures - Underhood/engine generated heat - Circuit generated heat due to a poor connection, or high electrical load - Higher than normal load conditions, towing, etc. - If the intermittent is related to cold, review the data for the following: Low ambient temperatures-In extremely low temperatures, ice may form in a connection or component. Inspect for water intrusion. - The condition only occurs on a cold start. - The condition goes away when the vehicle warms up. - Information from the customer may help to determine if the trouble follows a pattern that is temperature related. - If temperature is suspected of causing an intermittent fault condition, attempt to duplicate the condition. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required. ELECTROMAGNETIC INTERFERENCE (EMI) AND ELECTRICAL NOISE Some electrical components/circuits are sensitive to electromagnetic interference (EMI) or other types of electrical noise. Inspect for the following conditions: A misrouted harness that is too close to high voltage/high current devices such as secondary ignition components, motors, generator etc-These components may induce electrical noise on a circuit that could interfere with normal circuit operation. - Electrical system interference caused by a malfunctioning relay, or a control module driven solenoid or switch-These conditions can cause a sharp electrical surge. Normally, the condition will occur when the malfunctioning component is operating. - Improper installation of non-factory or aftermarket add on accessories such as lights, 2-way radios, amplifiers, electric motors, remote starters, alarm systems, cell phones, etc-These accessories may lead to interference while in use, but do not fail when the accessories are not in use. - Test for an open diode across the A/C compressor clutch and for other open diodes. Some relays may contain a clamping diode. - The generator may be allowing AC noise into the electrical system. INCORRECT CONTROL MODULE - There are only a few situations where reprogramming a control module is appropriate: A new service control module is installed. Page 4880 Page 1122 Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under the 5 year / 100,000 mile (160,000 km) emission warranty, use: Warranty Information (Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 777 Engine Control Module (ECM) C2 (Pin 1 To 10) Page 2245 REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. The release tab is located on the top of the wiredress cover. View of connector in released position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Page 6899 - JST connectors have JST in small letters on their connectors, similar to that above. The location of the logo will vary with the connector size and style. - Kostel has an "LK" with a circle around it. These connector are usually used as a transmissions connection and are currently use on some Cadillac vehicles. Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 04-06-04-054B Date: November 18, 2010 Subject: Info - Non-GM Parts and Accessories (Aftermarket) Models: 2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years and update to the new U.S. Fixed Operation Manager (FOM) and Canada Warranty Manager (WM) names. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 04-06-04-054A (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). The recent rise and expansion of companies selling non-GM parts and accessories has made it necessary to issue this reminder to dealers regarding GM's policy on the use and installation of these aftermarket components. When a dealer is performing a repair under the New Vehicle Limited Warranty, they are required to use only genuine GM or GM-approved parts and accessories. This applies to all warranty repairs, special policy repairs or any repairs paid for by GM. Parts and accessories advertised as being "the same" as parts manufactured by GM, but not sold through GM, do not qualify for use in warranty repairs, special policy repairs or any repairs paid for by GM. During a warranty repair, if a GM original equipment part is not available through GM Customer Care and Aftersales (GM CC&A;), ACDelco(R) distributors, other GM dealers or approved sources, the dealer is to obtain comparable, non-GM parts and clearly indicate, in detail, on the repair order the circumstances surrounding why non-GM parts were used. The dealer must give customers written notice, prior to the sale or service, that such parts or accessories are not marketed or warranted by General Motors. It should also be noted that dealers modifying new vehicles and installing equipment, parts and accessories obtained from sources not authorized by GM are responsible for complying with the National Traffic and Motor Vehicle Safety Act. Certain non-approved parts or assemblies, installed by the dealer or its agent not authorized by GM, may result in a change to the vehicle's design characteristics and may affect the vehicle's ability to conform to federal law. Dealers must fully understand that non-GM approved parts may not have been validated, tested or certified for use. This puts the dealer at risk for potential liability in the event of a part or vehicle failure. If a GM part failure occurs as the result of the installation or use of a non-GM approved part, the warranty will not be honored. A good example of non-authorized modification of vehicles is the result of an ever increasing supply of aftermarket devices available to the customer, which claim to increase the horsepower and torque of the Duramax(TM) Diesel Engines. These include the addition of, but are not limited to one or more of the following modifications: - Propane injection - Nitrous oxide injection - Additional modules (black boxes) that connect to the vehicle wiring systems - Revised engine calibrations downloaded for the engine control module - Calibration modules which connect to the vehicle diagnostic connector - Modification to the engine turbocharger waste gate Although the installation of these devices, or modification of vehicle components, can increase engine horsepower and torque, they may also negatively affect the engine emissions, reliability and/or durability. In addition, other powertrain components, such as transmissions, universal joints, drive shafts, and front/rear axle components, can be stressed beyond design safety limits by the installation of these devices. General Motors does not support or endorse the use of devices or modifications that, when installed, increase the engine horsepower and torque. It is because of these unknown stresses, and the potential to alter reliability, durability and emissions performance, that GM has adopted a policy that prevents any UNAUTHORIZED dealer warranty claim submissions to any remaining warranty coverage, to the powertrain and driveline components whenever the presence of a non-GM (aftermarket) calibration is confirmed - even if the non-GM control module calibration is subsequently removed. Refer to the latest version of Bulletin 09-06-04-026 (V8 Gas Engines) or 06-06-01-007 (Duramax(TM) Diesel Engines) for more information on dealer requirements for calibration verification. These same policies apply as they relate to the use of non-GM accessories. Damage or failure from the use or installation of a non-GM accessory will not be covered under warranty. Failure resulting from the alteration or modification of the vehicle, including the cutting, welding or disconnecting of the vehicle's original equipment parts and components will void the warranty. Additionally, dealers will NOT be reimbursed or compensated by GM in the event of any legal inquiry at either the local, state or federal level that Page 476 Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. For connectors with a bolt in the dress cover, turn the bolt counterclockwise to remove the connector from the component. 2. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. Page 8287 4. Slide the dress cover forward and off of the connector. 5. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front and rear of the connector. Page 7445 4. Install the fuel feed (1) and EVAP (2) lines to the sender assembly. 5. Install the fuel tank. Page 8271 7. Apply pressure and gently rock the cover until one locking leg is unseated. 8. Continue to apply pressure and rock the cover until the second locking leg is unseated. Repeat procedure for the other side of the dress cover and remove the cover. 9. Use J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) to gently lift the terminal retaining tab while gently pulling the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 10. If the terminal is severely bent or damaged, it may be possible on some connectors to push the wire out of the front of the connector instead of Page 6691 2. Locate the nose piece locking tabs that are positioned on the side of the connector nose piece. The connector nose piece acts as a terminal positive assurance (TPA) and may be referred to as such. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to push in one of the locking tabs while gently pulling on the same side of the nose piece. 4. Repeat the procedure for the other locking tab and remove the nose piece. 5. Remove the wire dress cover. The following is a general procedure for wire dress cover removal. Use this procedure as a guide, some dress cover removal procedures may vary. 6. Use fingers to squeeze the 2 locking legs of the cover. Page 5285 Page 5041 Exhaust Manifold: Service and Repair Exhaust Manifold Replacement - Right Side Exhaust Manifold Replacement - Right Side 1. Raise and suitably support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 2. Remove the nuts securing the catalytic converter to the right exhaust manifold. 3. Lower the vehicle. 4. Remove the spark plugs. Refer to Spark Plug Replacement for the 5.3L engine or Spark Plug Replacement for the 6.0L engine. 5. Remove the heat shield bolts, and shield from the exhaust manifold. 6. Remove the exhaust manifold bolts, manifold, and gasket. 7. Discard the gasket. 8. Clean and inspect the exhaust manifold. Refer to Exhaust Manifold Cleaning and Inspection for the 5.3L engine or Exhaust Manifold Cleaning and Inspection for the 6.0L engine. Installation Procedure Important: ^ Tighten the exhaust manifold bolts as specified in the service procedure. Improperly installed and/or leaking exhaust manifold gaskets may affect vehicle emissions and/or On-Board Diagnostics (OBD) II system performance. ^ The cylinder head exhaust manifold bolt hole threads must be clean and free of debris or threadlocking material. Page 5484 2. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully push the terminal position assurance (TPA) towards the face of the connector on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA is fragile and may break if not done carefully. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. 3. Use the J 38125-215 tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 2158 Release the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the blue locking tabs on both ends of the connector. Gently slide the TPA up to the released position on both ends. 6. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-13A (GM P/N 12031876-1) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. Page 7425 Engine Control Module (ECM) C2 (Pin 11 To 54) Page 7369 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the TPA. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the nose piece. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. Page 6463 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the rear TPA from the connector. 7. IMPORTANT: The front TPA cannot be removed from the connector. Only move it to the release point. Use a small flat-blade tool to move the front TPA to the release position. 8. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 9. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Molex Connectors Cooling System - Inspecting Radiator/Heater Hose Clamps Coolant Line/Hose: Technical Service Bulletins Cooling System - Inspecting Radiator/Heater Hose Clamps INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 06-06-02-014B Date: June 13, 2008 Subject: Inspecting Radiator and Heater Hose Clamps and Seals for Leaks During Pre-Delivery Inspection (PDI) Models: 2007 Buick Rainier 2007-2009 Chevrolet TrailBlazer, TrailBlazer SS 2007-2009 GMC Envoy 2007-2009 Saab 9-7X Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2009 model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 06-06-02-014A (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). The purpose of this bulletin is to inform dealers of required inspection of underhood and under vehicle radiator and heater hose clamps and seals for leaks and/or seepage during pre-delivery inspection (PDI). Field feedback indicates that some customers may notice engine coolant leaks shortly after delivery, which may result in an immediate decline of customer satisfaction with their new vehicle purchase. When performing a PDI on a vehicle listed in the models affected above, pay specific attention to the effectiveness of the engine coolant hose seal locations. Reposition/reclamp or replace the clamp to effect a proper system seal prior to customer delivery. Locations to Inspect During PDI Dealership personnel should examine the following locations closely during PDI (4.2L LL8 application shown in graphics below; refer to SI for specific information on 5.3L LH6 and 6.0L LS2):L LH6 and 6.0L LS2): 1. Radiator inlet hose (upper hose) to radiator (1). 2. Radiator inlet hose (upper hose) to engine (2). Engine Controls - MIL ON/Misfire/Misfire DTC's Set Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL ON/Misfire/Misfire DTC's Set Bulletin No.: 06-06-04-046 Date: September 12, 2006 INFORMATION Subject: Information on Engine Misfire MIL/SES Light Illuminated or Flashing DTC P0300, P0301, P0302, P0303, P0304, P0305, P0306, P0307, P0308, P0420 or P0430 Models: 1999-2007 Cadillac, Chevrolet, GMC Full-Size Pickup and/or Utility Trucks with 4.8L, 5.3L, 5.7L, 6.0L or 6.2L VORTEC GEN III, GEN IV, V-8 Engine (VINs V, C, T, Z, B, 3, M, 0, J, R, U, N, Y, K, 8 - RPOs LR4, LY2, LM7, L59, L33, LC9, LH6, LMG, LY5, L31, LQ4, LQ9, L76, LY6, L92) with Active Fuel Management(TM) and E85 Flex Fuel If you encounter vehicles that exhibit the above conditions, refer to SI for the appropriate DTC(s) set. If no trouble is found, the cause may be due to an ECM ground terminal that has corroded with rust over time. Inspect the main engine wiring harness ground terminal (G103) for this condition. The wire terminal (G103) attaches either to the front or to the rear of the right side cylinder head, depending on the model year of the Full Size Pickup and/or Utility Trucks. If the ECM ground terminal has been found to be corroded, then follow the service procedure outlined in this bulletin to correct the corrosion issue. Remove either the nut or bolt securing the main engine wiring harness ground terminal (G103) to the right cylinder head. Refer to the above illustration to determine where the ground is located on the vehicle (1). Page 5889 5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape. Seat Belt Schematic Icons Seat Belt Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons Page 5629 under pressure if the radiator cap or the surge tank cap is removed while the engine and radiator are still hot. 4. Remove the surge tank fill cap from the surge tank or the coolant pressure cap from the radiator. 5. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle in SI. 6. Place a clean drain pan under the radiator drain cock or under the lower radiator hose depending on the vehicle. Refer to Cooling System Draining and Filling in SI. 7. Loosen the radiator drain cock if equipped or use J 38185 clamp pliers and reposition the clamp on the lower radiator hose at the radiator. 8. Remove the end of the lower radiator hose from the radiator. 9. Drain the engine coolant sufficiently below the level of the ECT sensor. 10. Close the radiator drain cock or connect the lower radiator hose at the radiator. 11. Use the J 38185 clamp pliers to place the clamp into the original position on the hose. 12. Lower the vehicle. 13. Disconnect the wiring harness connector from the ECT sensor (2). 14. Remove the ECT sensor (1) from the front of the cylinder head. 15. Remove the corresponding size plug at the rear of the OTHER cylinder head. 16. Coat the threads of the ECT sensor with sealer. Use GM P/N 12346004 (Canadian P/N 10953480) or an equivalent. 17. Install the ECT sensor in the hole of the cylinder head where the plug was removed. Tighten Tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb ft). 18. Coat the threads of the plug with sealer. Use GM P/N 12346004 (Canadian P/N 10953480) or an equivalent. 19. Install the plug in the hole of the cylinder head where the ECT sensor was removed Tighten Tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb ft). Important Leave enough wire attached to the ECT sensor harness connector in order to create manageable splices that are at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splice. Page 3138 Allow at least a two hour soak time between engine OFF and start up when evaluating the tick noise. 2. Start the engine and evaluate the valve lifter tick noise. ‹› If the valve lifter tick noise is still present, replace all 16 valve lifters. Refer to Valve Lifter Replacement in SI. Parts Information Note A V8 AFM engine requires 8 AFM lifters and 8 non-AFM lifters for a total of 16 lifters. Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use: Warranty Information (Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 4495 11. Insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) into the 2 triangular cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 12. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE 1. Prior to installation the terminal must be aligned so the (1) coding lugs align with the (2) coding grooves on the connector. 2. Once the terminal is aligned, slide the terminal into the cavity until the retainer has engaged in the cavity of the connector. 3. Slide the TPA in the connector body and seat it using a small flat bladed tool. The TPA is seated when it is flush with the contact housing. 4. Secure the wires to the connector body using a tie wrap and replace the dress cover and grommet. Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) BOSCH CONNECTORS (2.8 JPT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Pull out the slider on the connector position assurance (CPA) until it is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 6294 Page 3381 Depress the locks that are located on both sides of the wiredress cover and pull the lever over and past the locks. View of the connector when released from the component. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the front of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool push down on one of the locking tabs and pull the cover up until the dress cover releases. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. Page 196 6. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs located on the opposite side of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover at the connector end and pry up. 7. Remove the dress cover. 8. Cut the tie wrap on the wire bundle. 9. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting a small flat-bladed tool into the small slot in the end of the slider and pushing on the TPA until it comes out of the connector. When the TPA exits the opposite side of the connector, gasp the TPA and pull it completely out of the connector. 10. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 4490 difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Bosch Connectors (ECM) BOSCH CONNECTORS (ECM) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the assist lever on the top of the connector. Move the assist lever to the forward position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 4413 2. Locate the two indents of the terminal position assurance (TPA) located on the bottom of the connector body. Page 5455 4. Use a small flat-blade tool to slide the terminal position assurance (TPA) up one notch on both ends of the connector. The TPA is located underneath the wire dress cover. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 3674 6. Lower the vehicle. Page 7008 Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids Arrows and Symbols Arrows and Symbols This Service Data uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations. Arrows and Symbols 1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow Basic Knowledge Required GENERAL ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures contained in the service manual. You should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current (amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram, as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. Decimal and Metric Equivalents Decimal and Metric Equivalents Engine Controls - MIL ON/Misfire/Misfire DTC's Set Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Engine Controls - MIL ON/Misfire/Misfire DTC's Set Bulletin No.: 06-06-04-046 Date: September 12, 2006 INFORMATION Subject: Information on Engine Misfire MIL/SES Light Illuminated or Flashing DTC P0300, P0301, P0302, P0303, P0304, P0305, P0306, P0307, P0308, P0420 or P0430 Models: 1999-2007 Cadillac, Chevrolet, GMC Full-Size Pickup and/or Utility Trucks with 4.8L, 5.3L, 5.7L, 6.0L or 6.2L VORTEC GEN III, GEN IV, V-8 Engine (VINs V, C, T, Z, B, 3, M, 0, J, R, U, N, Y, K, 8 - RPOs LR4, LY2, LM7, L59, L33, LC9, LH6, LMG, LY5, L31, LQ4, LQ9, L76, LY6, L92) with Active Fuel Management(TM) and E85 Flex Fuel If you encounter vehicles that exhibit the above conditions, refer to SI for the appropriate DTC(s) set. If no trouble is found, the cause may be due to an ECM ground terminal that has corroded with rust over time. Inspect the main engine wiring harness ground terminal (G103) for this condition. The wire terminal (G103) attaches either to the front or to the rear of the right side cylinder head, depending on the model year of the Full Size Pickup and/or Utility Trucks. If the ECM ground terminal has been found to be corroded, then follow the service procedure outlined in this bulletin to correct the corrosion issue. Remove either the nut or bolt securing the main engine wiring harness ground terminal (G103) to the right cylinder head. Refer to the above illustration to determine where the ground is located on the vehicle (1). Page 5954 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. 4. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front of the connector. Page 8212 5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape. Seat Belt Schematic Icons Seat Belt Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons Page 4021 Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 1. Install the engine mount bracket spacer if necessary. Tighten the spacer bolts to 50 N.m (37 lb ft). Important: Verify that the cut out side of the engine mount shield is positioned away from the engine. 2. Install the engine mount to the upper engine mount bracket. Tighten the engine mount nuts to 50 N.m (37 lb ft). Page 6323 - Kostel - Molex - Sumitomo - Tyco/AMP - Yazaki Identifying the manufacturer of a connector is often difficult. When trying to determine the manufacturer of a connector, look for specific identifying marks that are unique to that connector supplier. Most of these identify marks are hard to find or see. Check the connector carefully and refer to the information below for pictures and descriptions of connector identification markings. - Most of AFLs connectors have EPC on their connector body. Some of the smaller connectors will not have any markings on them. - In some cases Bosch will actually be printed on the connector. If Bosch does not appear on the connector, look for the Bosch logo. The Bosch logo is a circle with a blunted arrow inside. This logo can appear anywhere on the connector and is often very small. Page 3326 Page 1841 MEASURING FREQUENCY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal. IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM to autorange to an appropriate range. 1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency measured. Measuring Voltage MEASURING VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit. 1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods: - Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. - Turn ON the engine. - Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls. - Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested. 3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The DMM displays the voltage measured at that point. Measuring Voltage Drop MEASURING VOLTAGE DROP NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points. Probing Electrical Connectors PROBING ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS Page 6357 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 3094 coolant system integrity and will no longer be considered a 5 yr/150,000 mile (240,000 km) coolant. Coolant Removal Services/Recycling The tables include all coolant recycling processes currently approved by GM. Also included is a primary phone number and demographic information. Used DEX-COOL(R) can be combined with used conventional coolant (green) for recycling. Depending on the recycling service and/or equipment, it is then designated as a conventional 2 yr/30,000 mile (50,000 km) coolant or DEX-COOL(R) 5 yr/150,000 mile (240,000 km) coolant. Recycled coolants as designated in this bulletin may be used during the vehicle(s) warranty period. DEX-COOL(R) Recycling The DEX-COOL(R) recycling service listed in Table 2 has been approved for recycling waste engine coolants (DEX-COOL) or conventional) to DEX-COOL(R) with 5 yr/150,000 mile (240,000 km) usability. Recycling Fluid Technologies is the only licensed provider of Recycled DEX-COOL(R) meeting GM6277M specifications and utilizes GM approved inhibitor packages. This is currently a limited program being monitored by GM Service Operations which will be expanded as demand increases. Conventional (Green) Recycling Page 4120 Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under the 5 year / 100,000 mile (160,000 km) emission warranty, use: Warranty Information (Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 3267 The first connector design of the Micro-Pack 100W (1) has a white connector interface that holds the terminals. The second design of the Micro-Pack 100W (2) has a gray interface to hold the terminals. Also, the first design has terminal cavities that are further apart (3 mm centerline) and offset from the other row of terminal cavities in the connector. The second design has terminals cavities that are closer together (2.54 mm centerline) and aligned vertically. One other way to identify the second design is the thin strip of material that runs along the outside of the cavities. IMPORTANT: There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W terminals which are very similar. Ensure that you have the correct terminal before crimping the new terminal to the wire. The first design connector uses the longer terminal (1) that has a raised area in front of the recess in the terminal. The second design connector uses the shorter terminal without the raised area. Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro-Pack 100W connectors. Some Micro-Pack 100W connector disassembly procedures will vary. Use this procedure as a guide. 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 7868 Body Control Module: Diagrams Body Control Module (BCM) C2 Body Control Module (BCM) C2 Page 8103 Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Diagrams Engine Controls Connector End Views Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor Page 3342 Page 3814 Valve Deactivation Solenoid: Testing and Inspection Cylinder Deactivation (Active Fuel Management) System Diagnosis Diagnostic Instructions * Perform the Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle prior to using this diagnostic procedure. See: Testing and Inspection/Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview/Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle * Strategy Based Diagnosis * Diagnostic Procedure Instructions Circuit Description To provide maximum fuel economy under light load driving conditions, the engine control module (ECM) will command the valve lifter oil manifold (VLOM) solenoids ON, to deactivate engine cylinders 1 and 7 on the left bank, and cylinders 4 and 6 on the right bank. The VLOM consists of 4 electrically operated normally closed solenoids, which directs pressurized engine oil to 8 deactivating valve lifters. All 4 VLOM solenoids are connected in parallel to a fused ignition circuit supplied by the powertrain relay. The control circuit for each solenoid is connected to an individual low side driver internal to the ECM. When enabling conditions for V4 mode are met, the ECM will command the low side driver to turn ON, in engine firing order sequence. Diagnostic Aids The VLOM solenoids are assigned to the following engine cylinders: * Solenoid # 1-Cylinder # 1 * Solenoid # 2-Cylinder # 4 * Solenoid # 3-Cylinder # 6 * Solenoid # 4-Cylinder # 7 Circuit/System Verification 1. If any DTCs are set, then repair those DTC first. Refer to Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle. See: Testing and Inspection/Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview/Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle 2. Start and idle the engine. 3. Allow the engine to reach normal engine operating temperature. The engine should idle smoothly without any misfires. If the engine misfires, refer to DTC P0300 - P0308. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/P Code Charts/P0300 4. Monitor the cylinder deactivation system data parameters with a scan tool. 5. Road test the vehicle under light throttle and load conditions that will allow the ECM to command V4 mode. If all enabling conditions are met for cylinder deactivation, and if no internal engine hydraulic/mechanical fault conditions are present, the ECM will continue operation in V4 mode. ‹› If the vehicle passes the Circuit/System Verification test, then review the active fuel management driving information in the Features and Controls section of the owners manual with the vehicle operator, or instruct the vehicle operator in the proper driving techniques to obtain V4 mode. ‹› If the vehicle does not pass the Circuit/System Verification test, then review the cylinder deactivation inhibit reasons listed on the scan tool. Circuit/System Testing Electrical System Testing Ignition ON and the engine OFF, command each VLOM solenoid ON and OFF using the scan tool. Standing next to the engine compartment, you should be able to hear the solenoid energize and de-energize with each command. If you cannot hear each solenoid energize and de-energize, then refer to DTC P3401, P3425, P3441, or P3449. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/P Code Charts/P3401 Mechanical System Testing 1. Connect a vacuum gage to the EVAP vacuum tube fitting on the electronic throttle body. DO NOT use a compound pressure and vacuum gage. The vacuum gage on a hand held vacuum pump will work fine for this test. 2. Start the engine. Allow the engine to reach normal operation temperature. 3. With a scan tool, command each VLOM solenoid ON, one at a time. Each time a solenoid is command ON, you should observe a fluctuating drop of intake manifold vacuum, and a misfire on the cylinder that was deactivated. ‹› If there is no fluctuating drop in engine vacuum, or the engine does not misfire, then refer to Cylinder Deactivation (Active Fuel Management) System Diagnosis. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Page 9032 - Most Molex connectors will have the Molex logo on the dresscover of the connector. In some cases the connectors may have MX followed by another letter. The third letter indicates where the connector was made. A connector with MXD is a Molex connector made in Detroit. Sumitomo has a unique symbol on their connector and possibly a part number. The symbol is similar to that of a diamond lying on its side, similar to that shown. The logo could appear anywhere but the most common place is at the wire side of the housing. Tyco/AMP has many different and unique connector designs. Some may or may not have identifiable marks on them. Page 3803 11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the solder equipment. 12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. 13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to cover the first piece of tape. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE SLEEVES TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit IMPORTANT: Use only dura seal splice sleeves. Other splice sleeves may not protect the splice from moisture or provide a good electrical connection. Use duraseal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. Use duraseal splice sleeves where there is special requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire using duraseal splice sleeves. Engine - Low Oil Lamp ON/Oil Leaks Oil Pressure Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Low Oil Lamp ON/Oil Leaks TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 07-06-01-004A Date: November 25, 2008 Subject: All Vortec(R) GEN IV V8 Engines - LY2 LS4 LC9 LH6 LMG LY5 LS2 L76 LY6 L92 LS7, Low Oil Level Indicator Lamp On and/or Engine Oil Leak (Reseal Oil Pressure Sensor) Models Supercede: This bulletin is being updated to include a labor operation number for CTS-V and Corvette models. Please discard Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 07-06-01-004 (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System). Condition Some customers may comment on a low oil level indicator lamp on and/or engine oil leak. Upon further investigation, the technician may find that the oil leak is at the oil pressure sensor that is threaded into the valve lifter oil manifold (VLOM) assembly and/or engine valley cover. Correction If the engine oil leak was found to be at the engine oil pressure sensor, then remove the oil pressure sensor and reseal with a pipe sealant with Teflon or equivalent, P/N 12346004 (in Canada, P/N 10953480). Refer to Engine Oil Pressure Sensor and/or Switch Replacement in SI. Parts Information Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models) Page 5134 8. Take a CLEAR digital picture of the Tech 2(R) Vehicle Information screen showing the engine Calibration IDs and Verification Numbers as shown above. Retain the printout information and the Tech 2(R) screen photograph with the repair order. 9. E-mail a copy of the picture to [email protected]. In the subject line of the e-mail include the phrase "V8 Cal" as well as the complete VIN and Dealer BAC. In the body of the e-mail, include the VIN, mileage, R.O. number and BAC. Include a brief description of the customer concern and cause of the concern. Note The dealer will receive an e-mail reply after the calibrations have been validated. The e-mail reply will advise the dealer if the calibrations are OEM. 10. Allow two hours for the PQC to verify the calibrations and set up the case details. ‹› If the PQC determines that the calibrations ARE aftermarket calibrations, DO NOT contact GM Technical Assistance to discuss warranty concerns on the aftermarket calibrations. ALL questions and concerns about warranty should be directed to the dealers Fixed Operations Manager (FOM), (Warranty Manager (WM) in Canada). 11. You may call the PQC two hours after submitting the e-mail for authorization to replace the assembly. This will provide them time to receive, review and set up a case on the request. Please be prepared to provide all the usual documentation that is normally required when requesting an assembly authorization from the PQC. Tech 2(R) Displaying All Zeroes for the Verification Numbers on the Calibration ID and Verification Number Screen If the Tech 2(R) that you are using displays all zeroes for the Verification Numbers as shown, then perform the following steps: 1. Update the Tech 2(R) with the latest software from TIS2WEB. 2. Turn OFF the ignition for 90 seconds. 3. Connect the Tech 2(R) to the vehicle. 4. Turn ON the ignition, and build the vehicle. Observe the Tech 2(R) Calibration ID and Verification Number screen for proper operation. ‹› If the Tech 2(R) screen still does not display properly, then turn OFF the ignition for 90 seconds again. Turn ON the ignition and observe the same screen for proper operation. Retrieving Calibrations From a Global A Vehicle This information applies to the 2010 Camaro and is typical of the procedure that will be used on Global A vehicles. 1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Connect the MDI to the Data Link Connector (DLC) of the vehicle. Note Use the USB port to make the following MDI connection: Page 7078 3. Ensure that the terminal release tang access panel is in the correct location to access the terminals. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) into the terminal release tang access slot located behind the access panel of the connector and press down on the terminal while carefully pulling the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Tyco/AMP Connectors (0.25 Cap) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (025 CAP) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component by pressing down on the connector position assurance (CPA). Page 8960 5. While pushing the terminal forward, insert the J 38125-24 in the release cavity above the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (43-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Page 3411 7. The illustration above identifies the entry canal where the terminal release tool will be inserted, and the terminal cavity. - Terminal (1) - Entry Canal (2) 8. Insert the J-38125-553 (15315247) tool into the entry canal and pry up on the terminal retainer. The terminal retainer is a small plastic piece on the top of the terminal. The terminal retainer must be held up while the terminal is pulled out of the connector. Page 7031 11. Insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) into the 2 triangular cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 12. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE 1. Prior to installation the terminal must be aligned so the (1) coding lugs align with the (2) coding grooves on the connector. 2. Once the terminal is aligned, slide the terminal into the cavity until the retainer has engaged in the cavity of the connector. 3. Slide the TPA in the connector body and seat it using a small flat bladed tool. The TPA is seated when it is flush with the contact housing. 4. Secure the wires to the connector body using a tie wrap and replace the dress cover and grommet. Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) BOSCH CONNECTORS (2.8 JPT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Pull out the slider on the connector position assurance (CPA) until it is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 1322 3. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. View showing depressing of the lever lock release tab. Page 7278 8. Take a CLEAR digital picture of the Tech 2(R) Vehicle Information screen showing the engine Calibration IDs and Verification Numbers as shown above. Retain the printout information and the Tech 2(R) screen photograph with the repair order. Note All pictures must be sent as a.jpg file. 9. E-mail a copy of the picture to [email protected]. In the subject line of the e-mail include the phrase "V8 Cal" as well as the complete VIN and Dealer BAC. In the body of the e-mail, include the VIN, mileage, R.O. number and BAC. Include a brief description of the customer concern and cause of the concern. Note The dealer will receive an e-mail reply after the calibrations have been validated. The e-mail reply will advise the dealer if the calibrations are OEM. 10. Allow two hours for the PQC to verify the calibrations and set up the case details. ‹› If the PQC determines that the calibrations ARE aftermarket calibrations, DO NOT contact GM Technical Assistance to discuss warranty concerns on the aftermarket calibrations. ALL questions and concerns about warranty should be directed to the dealers Fixed Operations Manager (FOM), (Warranty Manager (WM) in Canada). 11. You may call the PQC two hours after submitting the e-mail for authorization to replace the assembly. This will provide them time to receive, review and set up a case on the request. Please be prepared to provide all the usual documentation that is normally required when requesting an assembly authorization from the PQC. Tech 2(R) Displaying All Zeroes for the Verification Numbers on the Calibration ID and Verification Number Screen If the Tech 2(R) that you are using displays all zeroes for the Verification Numbers as shown, then perform the following steps: 1. Update the Tech 2(R) with the latest software from TIS2WEB. 2. Turn OFF the ignition for 90 seconds. 3. Connect the Tech 2(R) to the vehicle. 4. Turn ON the ignition, and build the vehicle. Observe the Tech 2(R) Calibration ID and Verification Number screen for proper operation. ‹› If the Tech 2(R) screen still does not display properly, then turn OFF the ignition for 90 seconds again. Turn ON the ignition and observe the same screen for proper operation. Retrieving Calibrations From a Global A Vehicle This information applies to the 2010 Camaro and is typical of the procedure that will be used on Global A vehicles. 1. Turn OFF the ignition. Page 3167 4. Install the ground, then the washer and then the bolt to the frame. Important: It is important to use the bolts, washers and nuts specified in this bulletin. These parts have been identified due to their conductive finish. 5. Install a washer and nut to the back side of the frame. Tighten Tighten the nut to 9 Nm (79 lb in). 6. Cover the front and back side of the repair area using Rubberized Undercoating. An additional check can be made to ensure a good connection for the battery cable to frame ground. It is possible for this ground to cause similar symptoms with the ABS as described above. *We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may be available from other sources. Parts Information Warranty Information Disclaimer Page 6001 7. Pressing the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool in the release cavity of the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and crimper in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (DOOR MODULE) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Side view of connector. View of top of connector. 1. Locate the assist lever and lock on the top of the connector. Page 8286 View of typical connector. View of connector in released position. 1. Locate the assist lever at the back of the connector. Move the assist lever to the rear position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the dress cover. Page 5696 The first connector design of the Micro-Pack 100W (1) has a white connector interface that holds the terminals. The second design of the Micro-Pack 100W (2) has a gray interface to hold the terminals. Also, the first design has terminal cavities that are further apart (3 mm centerline) and offset from the other row of terminal cavities in the connector. The second design has terminals cavities that are closer together (2.54 mm centerline) and aligned vertically. One other way to identify the second design is the thin strip of material that runs along the outside of the cavities. IMPORTANT: There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W terminals which are very similar. Ensure that you have the correct terminal before crimping the new terminal to the wire. The first design connector uses the longer terminal (1) that has a raised area in front of the recess in the terminal. The second design connector uses the shorter terminal without the raised area. Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro-Pack 100W connectors. Some Micro-Pack 100W connector disassembly procedures will vary. Use this procedure as a guide. 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 3453 Fuse Block - Rear C3 (Pin A1 To E3) Page 3343 Page 2742 Steering Angle Sensor: Service and Repair Steering Wheel Position Sensor or Steering Shaft Lower Bearing Replacement Removal Procedure Caution: Refer to SIR Caution. 1. Disable the SIR system. Refer to SIR Disabling and Enabling. Notice: The wheels of the vehicle must be straight ahead and the steering column in the LOCK position before disconnecting the steering column or intermediate shaft from the steering gear. Failure to do so will cause the SIR coil assembly to become uncentered, which may cause damage to the coil assembly. 2. Position the front wheels straight ahead and lock the steering column to prevent rotation of the steering wheel. 3. Remove the intermediate shaft from the steering column. Refer to Upper Intermediate Steering Shaft Replacement. 4. Remove the steering wheel position sensor retainer screws (1). 5. Remove the steering wheel position sensor retainer (2) from the base of the steering column. 6. Disconnect the electrical connector from the steering wheel position sensor. 7. Remove the steering wheel position sensor (3) from the steering column. Installation Procedure Page 783 Engine Control Module: Service Precautions Powertrain Control Module and Electrostatic Discharge Notice Notice: Do not touch the connector pins or soldered components on the circuit board in order to prevent possible electrostatic discharge (ESD) damage to the PCM. Page 7351 - In some cases Delphi will actually be printed on the connector. If Delphi is not printed on the connector, look for PED. In both cases there is no specific orientation for Delphi or PED and they can appear anywhere on the connector. - FCI connectors may have the FCI logo on their connectors. The logo is the letters FCI with an "A" above it. - JAE connector have JAE in small letters on their connectors. Page 6734 Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size. REPAIRING A FUSIBLE LINK IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient overload protection. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. Flat Wire Repairs FLAT WIRE REPAIRS NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced. GMLAN Wiring Repairs GMLAN WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The GM Local Area Network (GMLAN) System requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working on GMLAN connectors and terminals. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items in order to repair the GMLAN wiring: Dura Seal splice sleeves - A wire stripping tool - J 38125-8 Crimping Tool (GM P/N 12085115) - J 38125-5 Ultra Torch Special Tool (GM P/N 12085116) The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. - A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors GMLAN REPAIRS IMPORTANT: When making a repair to any GMLAN network, the original wire length after the repair must be the same length as before the repair. If the network is a twisted pair, the twist must be maintained after the repair is completed. GMLAN has 2 types of networks, low speed and high speed. Low speed GMLAN has a single wire and works at slow speeds. High speed GMLAN has 2 wires in a twisted pair and works at higher speeds. For more information on GMLAN, refer to Data Link Communications Description and Operation. GMLAN CONNECTOR TERMINAL REPAIR IMPORTANT: A service terminal can be used to replace damaged connector terminals for both high speed and low speed GMLAN systems. When making a connector terminal repair on a GMLAN high speed system with twisted pair wires, do not untwist the wires more than necessary to make the repair. The terminals in the GMLAN system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are available in the J-38125. If the individual terminals are damaged on any GMLAN connection, use the appropriate connector repair procedure in order to repair the terminal. GMLAN WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 6648 Page 2423 OnStar(R) - Number Incorrect/Incorrectly Assigned Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Number Incorrect/Incorrectly Assigned INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 05-08-46-004C Date: December 23, 2010 Subject: OnStar(R) Phone Number Concerns (Phone Number Incorrect/Assigned to Another Vehicle/Phone) That Occur During Diagnosis of OnStar(R) System Models: 2000-2011 GM Passenger Cars and Trucks Equipped with OnStar(R) (RPO UE1) Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update model years up to 2011. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 05-08-46-004B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories). During diagnosis of an OnStar(R) concern, the technician may be told that the OnStar(R) phone number is incorrect or tied to another vehicle and/or phone of some kind. To resolve these concerns, the Tech 2(R) with software version 22.005 (or higher), has the capability to change the OnStar(R) phone number. Service Procedure 1. With the Tech 2(R), build the vehicle to specifications within the Diagnostics area of the Tech 2(R). 2. For vehicles with physical-based diagnostics - under Body, go to the OnStar(R) section. Then select the Special Functions menu. For vehicles with functional-based diagnostics - under Body and Accessories, go to the Cellular Communication section. Select Module Setup and then Vehicle Communication Interface Module. 3. Locate the Program Phone Number prompt and select it. The original phone number will be displayed on the Tech 2(R) screen. 4. Contact the OnStar(R) team at the GM Technical Assistance Center (TAC) to obtain a new phone number. 5. Highlight the digits of the phone number one at a time and enter the new phone number using the number keys on the Tech 2(R). 6. Press the Soft key at the base of the screen for Done once these numbers have been changed on the screen. 7. Press the Soft key for Done again. The area code or new phone number has now been programmed into the phone. 8. Cycle the ignition to Off and open the driver's door. 9. Press the blue OnStar(R) button to make sure that a normal connection can be made to the OnStar(R) call center. If applicable, make sure the Hands-Free Calling (HFC) works properly by making a phone call. 10. If the system is working properly, fax or voicemail a case closing into the OnStar(R) team at TAC with the results. Dealers in Canada should submit case closing information through the GM infoNET. Please follow this diagnostic process thoroughly and complete each step. If the condition exhibited is resolved WITHOUT completing every step, the remaining steps do not need to be performed. If the procedure above does not resolve the condition, you must contact TAC for further assistance. This diagnostic approach was developed specifically for this condition and should not automatically be used for other vehicles with similar symptoms. Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use: Warranty Information (Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Page 3869 1. Install the valve lifter. Refer to Valve Lifter Installation. 2. Install the cylinder head and gasket. Refer to Cylinder Head Replacement - Left Side or to Cylinder Head Replacement - Right Side. Locations Alarm Module: Locations Immobilizer Component Views Steering Column 1 - Ignition Lock Cylinder Case 2 - Theft Deterrent Control Module Page 436 The engine harness may be repaired using the J-38125. High Temperature Wiring Repairs HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperatures, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time may use materials i.e. wires, connectors, and shielding that has a higher heat rating than typical wiring. When making a repair in a high temperature area observe the following: Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature to replace any damaged wire. - Replace any heat shielding that is removed. - Cover any DuraSeal splice sleeves with SCT1 shrink tubing (available in the J-38125 Terminal Repair kit). - After making a wiring repair, ensure that the location of the wiring is not moved closer to the heat source. IDENTIFYING HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperature, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time need special considerations when making wiring repairs. Areas that may be exposed to higher temperatures can be identified by heat resistant materials that are being used in those areas. These materials may include heat reflective tape, moon tape, and high temperature shrink tubing. Also conduit and other protective coverings may be used. Because conduit or similar coverings are used throughout the vehicle regardless of the temperature, it may be necessary for the technician to determine if an area is exposed to excessive heat before making a wiring repair. Obvious areas of consideration would be any area located near the exhaust manifolds, catalytic converter, and exhaust pipes. The J-38125 contains much of the material you will need to perform repairs on areas exposed to high heat. The kit contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves to crimp and seal connections - High temperature SCT1 shrink tubing to protect the splice sleeves - A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct crimp tool to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools to remove the terminals from the connectors The J-38125 does not contain wire that is suitable to high temperature exposure. Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature of the same or larger gage size as the original wire when repair damage wire. Also replace any reflective tape that you remove during the repair. HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature rating of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125 and then encapsulate the splice sleeve using the high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the order listed. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip keeping all of the wire strands intact. Page 2250 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Kostal Connectors KOSTAL CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 691 3. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. View showing depressing of the lever lock release tab. Page 3258 - In some cases Delphi will actually be printed on the connector. If Delphi is not printed on the connector, look for PED. In both cases there is no specific orientation for Delphi or PED and they can appear anywhere on the connector. - FCI connectors may have the FCI logo on their connectors. The logo is the letters FCI with an "A" above it. - JAE connector have JAE in small letters on their connectors. Page 4389 - Kostel - Molex - Sumitomo - Tyco/AMP - Yazaki Identifying the manufacturer of a connector is often difficult. When trying to determine the manufacturer of a connector, look for specific identifying marks that are unique to that connector supplier. Most of these identify marks are hard to find or see. Check the connector carefully and refer to the information below for pictures and descriptions of connector identification markings. - Most of AFLs connectors have EPC on their connector body. Some of the smaller connectors will not have any markings on them. - In some cases Bosch will actually be printed on the connector. If Bosch does not appear on the connector, look for the Bosch logo. The Bosch logo is a circle with a blunted arrow inside. This logo can appear anywhere on the connector and is often very small. Engine - Valve Lifter Tick Noise At Start Up Oil Filter: Customer Interest Engine - Valve Lifter Tick Noise At Start Up TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 10-06-01-007C Date: February 09, 2011 Subject: Active Fuel Management (AFM) Engine, Valve Lifter Tick Noise at Start Up When Engine Has Been Off for 2 Hours or More (Evaluate Noise and/or Replace Valve Lifters) Models: 2007 Buick Rainier 2009 Buick LaCrosse Super, Allure Super (Canada Only) 2007 Cadillac Escalade Built Prior to April 1, 2006 with 6.2L Engine RPO L92 (These engines were built with AFM Hardware but the AFM system was disabled) 2010-2011 Cadillac Escalade, Escalade ESV, Escalade EXT 2007 Chevrolet Monte Carlo 2007-2009 Chevrolet Impala 2007-2011 Chevrolet Avalanche, Silverado, Suburban, Tahoe, TrailBlazer, TrailBlazer EXT 2010-2011 Chevrolet Camaro SS 2007-2011 GMC Envoy, Envoy XL, Sierra, Yukon, Yukon Denali, Yukon XL, Yukon XL Denali 2007-2008 Pontiac Grand Prix 2008-2009 Pontiac G8 2007-2009 Saab 9-7X Equipped with AFM (Active Fuel Management) and V8 Engine RPO L76, L94, L99, LC9, LFA, LH6, LMG, LS4, LY5 or LZ1 Attention: This bulletin only applies to the AFM V8 engines listed above. It DOES NOT apply to Non-AFM Engines. If you are dealing with a Non-AFM engine that is experiencing a similar noise, please refer to Engine Mechanical > Diagnostic Information and Procedures > Symptoms in SI. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add models. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 10-06-01-007B (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). Condition Some customers may comment on an engine valve lifter tick noise that occurs after the engine has been shut off for at least two hours. The tick noise may last from two seconds to ten minutes. Cause This condition may be caused by any of the following: - Aerated oil in the valve lifter body, resulting in the valve lifter being unable to purge the air quickly. - A low engine oil level or incorrect oil viscosity. - Dirty or contaminated oil. - A low internal valve lifter oil reservoir level. - Debris in the valve lifter. - A high valve lifter leak down rate. Correction If the SI diagnostics do not isolate the cause of this valve lifter tick noise and normal oil pressure is noted during the concern, perform the following steps: 1. Inspect the engine oil condition and level. Refer to Owner Manual > Service and Appearance Care > Checking Things Under the Hood > Description and Operation > Engine Oil in SI. ‹› If the engine oil is more than one quart low, an incorrect oil viscosity is being used or if poor quality/contamination is observed, change the oil and filter. Note Page 3396 4. Use a small flat-blade tool to slide the terminal position assurance (TPA) up one notch on both ends of the connector. The TPA is located underneath the wire dress cover. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 881 4. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the rear of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. 5. Once the locking tabs are unlocked, slide the inner connector out of the rear of the connector housing. Page 4945 3. Remove the dress cover by using a flat-blade tool to release the connector locking tabs and pulling off the dress cover. 4. Relieve the tension on the nose piece retainers by inserting J-38125-12A (12094429) into the single retainer slot on the end of the nose piece and gently prying out the locking tab. Repeat the process for both of the nose piece locking tabs on the opposite side of the nose piece. Page 3363 View of connector in released position. 4. Disconnect the connector from the component. 5. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Release the rear lower half of the wiredress cover. Page 7354 - Yazaki has a wedge or arrow shape, similar to that shown. Delphi Connectors (Micro .64) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro 64 connectors. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. The lever lock may be located on the top or sides of the wire dress cover. Page 1863 - In some cases Delphi will actually be printed on the connector. If Delphi is not printed on the connector, look for PED. In both cases there is no specific orientation for Delphi or PED and they can appear anywhere on the connector. - FCI connectors may have the FCI logo on their connectors. The logo is the letters FCI with an "A" above it. - JAE connector have JAE in small letters on their connectors. Page 3867 Installation Procedure Important: ^ All gasket surfaces should be free of oil or other foreign material during assembly. ^ Do not allow dirt or debris to enter the manifold. Plug as required. Install the service gasket (1) onto the manifold. 1. Install the manifold (2) with gasket. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Install the manifold bolts (1). Tighten the manifold bolts to 25 N.m (18 lb ft). 3. Connect the electrical connector to the oil pressure sensor. 4. Install the intake manifold. Refer to Intake Manifold Replacement. Fuel Pressure Relief Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair Fuel Pressure Relief Fuel Pressure Relief Tools Required CH-48027 Digital Pressure Gage With CH-48027 Caution: Refer to Gasoline/Gasoline Vapors Caution. Caution: Remove the fuel tank cap and relieve the fuel system pressure before servicing the fuel system in order to reduce the risk of personal injury. After you relieve the fuel system pressure, a small amount of fuel may be released when servicing the fuel lines, the fuel injection pump, or the connections. In order to reduce the risk of personal injury, cover the fuel system components with a shop towel before disconnection. This will catch any fuel that may leak out. Place the towel in an approved container when the disconnection is complete. 1. Remove the engine cover, if required. 2. Loosen the fuel fill cap in order to relieve the fuel tank vapor pressure. 3. Remove the fuel rail service port cap. Caution: Wrap a shop towel around the fuel pressure connection in order to reduce the risk of fire and personal injury. The towel will absorb any fuel leakage that occurs during the connection of the fuel pressure gage. Place the towel in an approved container when the connection of the fuel pressure gage is complete. 4. Wrap a shop towel around the fuel rail service port. 5. Connect the CH-48027-3 (4) to the fuel rail service port. 6. Connect the CH-48027-2 (2) to the CH-48027-3 (4). 7. Place the hose on the CH-48027-2 (2) into an approved gasoline container. 8. Open the valve on the CH-48027-2 (2) in order to bleed any fuel from the fuel rail. 9. Close the valve on the CH-48027-2 (2). 10. Remove the hose on the CH-48027-2 (2) from the approved gasoline container. Important: If relieving the fuel pressure for the fuel pressure gage installation and removal, it is NOT necessary to proceed with the following steps. Notice: Clean all of the following areas before performing any disconnections in order to avoid possible contamination in the system: * The fuel pipe connections Page 2103 difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Bosch Connectors (ECM) BOSCH CONNECTORS (ECM) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the assist lever on the top of the connector. Move the assist lever to the forward position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 5957 6. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs located on the opposite side of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover at the connector end and pry up. 7. Remove the dress cover. 8. Cut the tie wrap on the wire bundle. 9. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting a small flat-bladed tool into the small slot in the end of the slider and pushing on the TPA until it comes out of the connector. When the TPA exits the opposite side of the connector, gasp the TPA and pull it completely out of the connector. 10. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 7619 difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Bosch Connectors (ECM) BOSCH CONNECTORS (ECM) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the assist lever on the top of the connector. Move the assist lever to the forward position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 806 Page 3535 Customer TPMS Information Page 2086 Page 1013 Page 4369 IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals. Front probe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the connector. IMPORTANT: When probing female 0.64 terminals, it is important to use the correct adapter. There have been some revisions to the test adapter for 0.64 terminals. The proper adapter for 0.64 terminals is the J 35616-64B which has a gold terminal and a black wire between the base and tip. Failure to use the proper test adapter may result in damage to the terminal being tested and improper diagnosis. NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Page 2512 11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the solder equipment. 12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. 13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to cover the first piece of tape. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE SLEEVES TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit IMPORTANT: Use only dura seal splice sleeves. Other splice sleeves may not protect the splice from moisture or provide a good electrical connection. Use duraseal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. Use duraseal splice sleeves where there is special requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire using duraseal splice sleeves. Page 4370 Refer to the following table as a guide in selecting the correct test adapter for front probing connectors: Backprobe IMPORTANT: Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures. - Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector. - Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large of a test probe. - After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected, test for proper terminal contact. Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the connector. Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure SCAN TOOL SNAPSHOT PROCEDURE Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used Page 8002 IMPORTANT: Ensure that the dress cover and connector body are both in the released position before reassembling. Failure to do so may cause damage to the connector and component. Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (0.64) BOSCH CONNECTORS (0.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While pressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock until the lever is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Pull the rubber boot that covers the wires back to expose the end of the connector dress cover. 4. Place the connector locking lever in the center of the connector. 5. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs that are on the wire end of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover and connector body and pry up. Page 2402 5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape. Seat Belt Schematic Icons Seat Belt Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons Page 4809 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert terminal into the appropriate terminal holder until it hits bottom and stops. The correct terminal holder is determined by the wire size. Also ensure that the terminals wings are pointing towards the former on the tool and the release locator. 5. Insert the stripped cable into the terminal. Insulation should be visible on both sides of the terminal insulation wings. 6. Compress the handles until the ratchet automatically releases. 7. Place the terminal into the appropriate cavity and assemble the connector. Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO-PACK 100W) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W connectors. These connectors are very similar but use different terminals and have some minor physical differences also. Page 1566 MEASURING FREQUENCY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal. IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM to autorange to an appropriate range. 1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency measured. Measuring Voltage MEASURING VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit. 1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods: - Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. - Turn ON the engine. - Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls. - Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested. 3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The DMM displays the voltage measured at that point. Measuring Voltage Drop MEASURING VOLTAGE DROP NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points. Probing Electrical Connectors PROBING ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS Page 8040 8. Insert the J 38125-213 into the small terminal release hole on the nose piece and gently pull on the back of the wire. 9. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Repairing Connector Terminals REPAIRING CONNECTOR TERMINALS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following: Push to Seat terminals - Pull to Seat terminals Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your terminal repair. The J-38125 contains further information. 1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.For cable seal terminals, remove the seal. 2. Apply the correct cable seal per gage size of the wire, if used.Slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation removal. 3. Remove the insulation. 4. For sealed terminals only, align the seal with the end of the cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal.For sealed terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal. 6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.For sealed terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable. 8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals excepting Micro-Pack 100.64 size. Soldering Micro-Pack 100 World terminals may damage the terminal. Sumitomo Connectors SUMITOMO CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 5941 IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals. Front probe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the connector. IMPORTANT: When probing female 0.64 terminals, it is important to use the correct adapter. There have been some revisions to the test adapter for 0.64 terminals. The proper adapter for 0.64 terminals is the J 35616-64B which has a gold terminal and a black wire between the base and tip. Failure to use the proper test adapter may result in damage to the terminal being tested and improper diagnosis. NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Page 7901 Note All pictures must be sent as a.jpg file. 27. E-mail a copy of the screenshot to [email protected]. In the subject line of the e-mail include the phrase "V8 Cal" as well as the complete VIN and Dealer BAC. In the body of the e-mail, include the VIN, mileage, R.O. number and BAC. Include a brief description of the customer concern and cause of the concern. Note The dealer will receive an e-mail reply after the calibrations have been validated. The e-mail reply will advise the dealer if the calibrations are OEM. 28. Allow two hours for the PQC to verify the calibrations and set up the case details. ‹› If the PQC determines that the calibrations ARE aftermarket calibrations, DO NOT contact GM Technical Assistance to discuss warranty concerns on the aftermarket calibrations. ALL questions and concerns about warranty should be directed to the dealers Fixed Operations Manager (FOM), (Warranty Manager (WM) in Canada). 29. You may call the PQC two hours after submitting the e-mail for authorization to replace the assembly. This will provide them time to receive, review and set up a case on the request. Please be prepared to provide all the usual documentation that is normally required when requesting an assembly authorization from the PQC. Warranty Information - The Dealership Service Management must be involved in any situation that would justify the use of labor operation Z1111. - Notify the Fixed Operations Manager (FOM) (Warranty Manager (WM) in Canada) of the situation. - All claims will have to be routed to the FOM (WM in Canada) for approval. - Please refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 09-00-89-016, Labor Operation Z1111 - Suspected Tampering or Vehicle Modifications for important information. For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Diagram Information and Instructions Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions Electrical Symbols Page 6983 Body Control Module: Diagrams Body Control Module (BCM) C2 Body Control Module (BCM) C2 Page 1893 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. 4. Remove the dress cover by using a flat bladed tool to release the dress cover locking tabs and lift up on the dress cover. 5. Cut the tie wrap that holds the wires to the connector body. Page 6791 Disclaimer Page 8462 11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the solder equipment. 12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. 13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to cover the first piece of tape. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE SLEEVES TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit IMPORTANT: Use only dura seal splice sleeves. Other splice sleeves may not protect the splice from moisture or provide a good electrical connection. Use duraseal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. Use duraseal splice sleeves where there is special requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire using duraseal splice sleeves. Page 8034 View of typical connector. View of connector in released position. 1. Locate the assist lever at the back of the connector. Move the assist lever to the rear position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the dress cover. Page 4171 Intake Manifold: Specifications Intake Manifold Bolts First Pass in Sequence ........................................................................................................................ ...................................................... 5 N.m (44 lb in) Final Pass in Sequence ...................................... ..................................................................................................................................... 10 N.m (89 lb in) Intake Manifold Wiring Harness Stud ........................................................................................................................................................ 10 N.m (89 lb in) Throttle Body Bolts ........................................................................................................ ............................................................................ 10 N.m (89 lb in) Throttle Body Nuts ...................... .............................................................................................................................................................. . 10 N.m (89 lb in) Throttle Body Studs ............................................................................................... ....................................................................................... 6 N.m (53 lb in) Page 6144 The engine harness may be repaired using the J-38125. High Temperature Wiring Repairs HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperatures, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time may use materials i.e. wires, connectors, and shielding that has a higher heat rating than typical wiring. When making a repair in a high temperature area observe the following: Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature to replace any damaged wire. - Replace any heat shielding that is removed. - Cover any DuraSeal splice sleeves with SCT1 shrink tubing (available in the J-38125 Terminal Repair kit). - After making a wiring repair, ensure that the location of the wiring is not moved closer to the heat source. IDENTIFYING HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperature, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time need special considerations when making wiring repairs. Areas that may be exposed to higher temperatures can be identified by heat resistant materials that are being used in those areas. These materials may include heat reflective tape, moon tape, and high temperature shrink tubing. Also conduit and other protective coverings may be used. Because conduit or similar coverings are used throughout the vehicle regardless of the temperature, it may be necessary for the technician to determine if an area is exposed to excessive heat before making a wiring repair. Obvious areas of consideration would be any area located near the exhaust manifolds, catalytic converter, and exhaust pipes. The J-38125 contains much of the material you will need to perform repairs on areas exposed to high heat. The kit contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves to crimp and seal connections - High temperature SCT1 shrink tubing to protect the splice sleeves - A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct crimp tool to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools to remove the terminals from the connectors The J-38125 does not contain wire that is suitable to high temperature exposure. Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature of the same or larger gage size as the original wire when repair damage wire. Also replace any reflective tape that you remove during the repair. HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature rating of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125 and then encapsulate the splice sleeve using the high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the order listed. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip keeping all of the wire strands intact. Page 5527 IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals. Front probe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the connector. IMPORTANT: When probing female 0.64 terminals, it is important to use the correct adapter. There have been some revisions to the test adapter for 0.64 terminals. The proper adapter for 0.64 terminals is the J 35616-64B which has a gold terminal and a black wire between the base and tip. Failure to use the proper test adapter may result in damage to the terminal being tested and improper diagnosis. NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Page 4451 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the DuraSeal splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of a connector. CPAs are used in all SIR System connectors and also in some connectors of other systems. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals of a connection. TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE CLIPS IMPORTANT: When making a splice in an area that may be exposed to moisture use a crimp and seal splice sleeve instead of a Splice Clip. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. Page 8936 4. Use a small flat-blade tool to slide the terminal position assurance (TPA) up one notch on both ends of the connector. The TPA is located underneath the wire dress cover. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 7571 Data Communication Diagram 1 Engine/Transmission - Aftermarket Calibrations Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine/Transmission - Aftermarket Calibrations INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 09-06-04-026B Date: April 07, 2010 Subject: Identifying Non-GM (Aftermarket) Engine and Transmission Calibrations for V8 Gas Engines Using Tech 2(R) or Global Diagnostic System (GDS) Models: 2006-2010 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Excluding Saab 9-7X) 2006-2009 HUMMER H2 2006-2010 HUMMER H3 Equipped with V8 Gas Powered Engines Only Attention: This bulletin applies to V8 gas powered engines ONLY. For Duramax(TM) diesel powered engines, refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 08-06-04-006G. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2010 model year and information about retrieving calibrations on a Global A vehicle. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 09-06-04-026A (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). General Motors is identifying an increasing number of engine, transmission and catalytic converter part failures that are the result of non-GM (aftermarket) engine and transmission control calibrations being used. When alteration to the GM-released engine or transmission control calibrations occurs, it subjects powertrain and driveline components (engine, transmission, transfer case, driveshaft and rear axle) to stresses that were not tested by General Motors. It is because of these unknown stresses, and the potential to alter reliability, durability and emissions performance, that GM has adopted a policy that prevents any UNAUTHORIZED dealer warranty claim submissions to any remaining warranty coverage, to the powertrain and driveline components whenever the presence of a non-GM (aftermarket) calibration is confirmed - even if the non-GM control module calibration is subsequently removed. Warranty coverage is based on the equipment and calibrations that were released on the vehicle at time of sale, or subsequently updated by GM. That's because GM testing and validation matches the calibration to a host of criteria that is essential to assure reliability, durability and emissions performance over the life of the warranty coverage and beyond. Stresses resulting from calibrations different from those tested and released by GM can damage or weaken components, leading to poor performance and or shortened life. Additionally, non-GM (aftermarket) issued engine control modifications often do not meet the same emissions performance standards as GM issued calibrations. Depending on state statutes, individuals who install engine control module calibrations that put the vehicle outside the parameters of emissions certification standards may be subject to fines and/or penalties. This bulletin outlines a procedure to identify the presence of non-GM (aftermarket) calibrations. GM recommends performing this check whenever a hard part failure is seen on internal engine or transmission components, or before an engine assembly or transmission assembly is being replaced under warranty. It is also recommended that the engine calibration verification procedure be performed whenever diagnostics indicate that catalytic converter replacement is indicated. The PQC has a process to confirm the ECM/PCM calibration is GM issued. The PQC will require a picture of the engine calibration verification screen, as outlined in this bulletin, before authorizing any V8 gas powered engine replacement. If a non-GM calibration is found and verification has taken place through GM, the remaining powertrain and driveline warranty will be blocked and notated in GMVIS and the dealership will be notified. This block prevents any UNAUTHORIZED warranty claim submission. 1. Connect the Tech 2(R) to the vehicle. 2. Go to: Diagnostics and build the vehicle. 3. Select: Powertrain. 4. Select: Engine. 5. *Select: Engine Control Module or PCM. 6. *Select: Module ID Information or I/M Information System if the Module ID Information selection is not available. 7. *If "I/M information System" was selected, it may be necessary to select "Vehicle Information" in order to display the calibration information. ‹› If the CVN information is displayed as "N/A", it will be necessary to contact the TCSC to obtain the CVN information. Page 3237 IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals. Front probe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the connector. IMPORTANT: When probing female 0.64 terminals, it is important to use the correct adapter. There have been some revisions to the test adapter for 0.64 terminals. The proper adapter for 0.64 terminals is the J 35616-64B which has a gold terminal and a black wire between the base and tip. Failure to use the proper test adapter may result in damage to the terminal being tested and improper diagnosis. NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Page 7016 to analyze the data during the time a vehicle condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a trigger point that you have determined. Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2 snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a first-in, first-out basis. If a third snapshot is taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost. Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types: Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice - Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200 frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not lost if the Scan Tool is powered down. The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis. The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected values by plotting 3 parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful, especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC. Testing for a Short to Voltage TESTING FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4. Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt, there is a short to voltage in the circuit. Testing for Continuity TESTING FOR CONTINUITY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6. Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit. 7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity. With a Test Lamp IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits. 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6. If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity. Testing for Electrical Intermittents TESTING FOR ELECTRICAL INTERMITTENTS Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment. - Testing for Short to Ground - Testing for Continuity - Testing for a Short to Voltage Page 4649 2. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 7219 5. While pushing the terminal forward, insert the J 38125-24 in the release cavity above the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (43-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Page 2237 pulling it through. This will prevent damage to the internal seals of the connector. Once the terminal is pushed out of the connector, cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible and pull the wire through the connector. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE The Micro-Pack 100W connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool was developed to crimp Micro-Pack 100W terminals. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 2. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert the terminal into the crimp tool until the core wings are flush with the anvil on the crimp tool. Be sure that the wings are pointed toward the crimp tool former and release the spring locator. The locator will hold the terminal in place. Inspect the alignment of the terminal wings with the crimp tool former. If the terminal wings are wider than the crimp tool former, remove the terminal and bend the terminal wings in slightly. 5. Place stripped wire into terminal. 6. Crimp the new terminal to the wire. If a jam occurs, press the emergency release to open applicator. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire perform the following procedure in order to replace Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. Page 5685 Connector Anatomy Connector Repairs contains a list of all connector repairs. The connector repairs are listed by the connector manufacturer and then by connector type. If the technician cannot identify the manufacturer of the connector, refer to Identifying Connectors below. Knowing the connector manufacturer will assist in finding the correct connector repair from the following list: - Connector Position Assurance Locks - Terminal Position Assurance Locks - Bosch Connectors (0.64) Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) Bosch Connectors (BSK) Bosch Connectors (ECM) - Delphi Connectors (Micro.64) Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) Delphi Connectors (12-Way) - Tyco/AMP Connectors (CM 42-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) Tyco/AMP Connectors (025 Cap) Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) - Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) - Repairing Connector Terminals IDENTIFYING CONNECTORS Knowing the connector manufacturer is helpful when trying to locating the correct connector repair procedure. There are many different connector designs used on GM vehicles and it is sometimes difficult to identify the connector manufacturer. The information in this document should help with the identification of connector manufactures. The following connector manufacturers make most of the connectors found in GM vehicles: AFL/EPC (Alcoa Fujikura Ltd./Engineered Plastics Components) - Bosch - Delphi - FCI (Framatome Connectors International) - JAE (Japan Aviation Electronics) - JST (Japan Solderless Terminals) Page 8939 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully raise the TPA on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA cannot be removed from the connector while there are terminals present in the connector body. View of the TPA when removed from the connector body. 4. Use the J 38125-12A tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the left side of the terminal release cavity as shown in the graphic. Use the tool to move the terminal release to the right with a gentle prying motion. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 7169 6. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs located on the opposite side of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover at the connector end and pry up. 7. Remove the dress cover. 8. Cut the tie wrap on the wire bundle. 9. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting a small flat-bladed tool into the small slot in the end of the slider and pushing on the TPA until it comes out of the connector. When the TPA exits the opposite side of the connector, gasp the TPA and pull it completely out of the connector. 10. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 272 Driver Door Module (DDM) C2 Page 8273 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Ensure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the Terminal Removal Procedure. Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PULL TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL If the terminal is visibly damaged or is suspected of having a faulty connection, the terminal should be replaced. Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors: 1. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) device and/or the secondary lock. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component or separate the connectors for in-line connectors. 3. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device. 4. Insert the proper pick or removal tool into the front of the connector body. 5. IMPORTANT: On connectors with more than one terminal the service loop may not be large enough to remove the terminal and crimp on a new one. If the terminal wire does not have a large enough service loop for removal, cut the wire 5 cm (2 in) behind the connector before removal. Grasp the wire at the back of the connector body and gently push the terminal out the front of the connector body. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. If the wire needed to be cut in order to remove the terminal, gently push a small length of the same size wire through the back of the connector cavity until there is enough wire exposed in order to crimp on a new terminal. If the wire was not cut, cut the existing wire as close to the old terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 4. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. TERMINAL INSTALLATION 1. Align the terminal and pull the wire from the back of the connector in order to seat the terminal. 2. If necessary, cut the new wire to proper length and splice with existing circuit. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. 3. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply dielectric grease to the connector. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PUSH TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 5414 Refer to the following table as a guide in selecting the correct test adapter for front probing connectors: Backprobe IMPORTANT: Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures. - Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector. - Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large of a test probe. - After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected, test for proper terminal contact. Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the connector. Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure SCAN TOOL SNAPSHOT PROCEDURE Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used Page 8386 3. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. View showing depressing of the lever lock release tab. Page 711 4. Once the front 2 locks are unlocked, lift the front of the dress cover and pull it forward. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the small slot on the TPA and pushing down until the TPA releases. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to angle or rock the J 38125-21 tool when inserting it into the connector or the tool may break. Insert the J 38125-21 (GM P/N 15381651-2) tool into the round canal between the terminals cavities at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to repair Micro 64 connector terminals. The Micro 64 connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-64 (M jaw) was developed to crimp Micro 64 terminals. The J 38125-64 crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. The J 38125-64 crimping tool is also designed to crimp both the wire and the insulation at the same time. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro 64 terminals. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. 1. Cut the wire as close to the damaged terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. Page 4510 7. Apply pressure and gently rock the cover until one locking leg is unseated. 8. Continue to apply pressure and rock the cover until the second locking leg is unseated. Repeat procedure for the other side of the dress cover and remove the cover. 9. Use J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) to gently lift the terminal retaining tab while gently pulling the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 10. If the terminal is severely bent or damaged, it may be possible on some connectors to push the wire out of the front of the connector instead of Page 195 IMPORTANT: Ensure that the dress cover and connector body are both in the released position before reassembling. Failure to do so may cause damage to the connector and component. Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (0.64) BOSCH CONNECTORS (0.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While pressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock until the lever is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Pull the rubber boot that covers the wires back to expose the end of the connector dress cover. 4. Place the connector locking lever in the center of the connector. 5. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs that are on the wire end of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover and connector body and pry up. Page 2476 4. Slide the dress cover forward and off of the connector. 5. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front and rear of the connector. Page 5055 Heat Shield: Service and Repair Exhaust Muffler Heat Shield Replacement Exhaust Muffler Heat Shield Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 2. Remove the catalytic converter heat shield rear 2 bolts where the catalytic converter heat shield connects to the muffler heat shield. 3. Remove the remaining exhaust muffler heat shield bolts and remove the heat shield from the floor panel studs. Installation Procedure 1. Install the muffler heat shield to the floor panel studs placing the muffler heat shield under the rear part of the converter heat shield. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Secure the muffler heat shield with 5 bolts. Tighten the exhaust muffler heat shield bolts to 7 N.m (62 lb in). 3. Lower the vehicle. Page 5666 IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals. Front probe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the connector. IMPORTANT: When probing female 0.64 terminals, it is important to use the correct adapter. There have been some revisions to the test adapter for 0.64 terminals. The proper adapter for 0.64 terminals is the J 35616-64B which has a gold terminal and a black wire between the base and tip. Failure to use the proper test adapter may result in damage to the terminal being tested and improper diagnosis. NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Page 6571 2. Locate the two indents of the terminal position assurance (TPA) located on the bottom of the connector body. Page 2085 Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids Arrows and Symbols Arrows and Symbols This Service Data uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations. Arrows and Symbols 1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow Basic Knowledge Required GENERAL ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures contained in the service manual. You should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current (amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram, as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. Decimal and Metric Equivalents Decimal and Metric Equivalents Page 3935 Important: ^ Ensure that the teeth of J 42386-A mesh with the teeth of the engine flywheel. ^ The used crankshaft balancer bolt will be used only during the first pass of the balancer installation procedure. Install a NEW bolt and tighten as described in the second pass of the balancer bolt tightening procedure. ^ The crankshaft balancer installation and bolt tightening involves a 4-stage tightening process. The first pass ensures that the balancer is installed completely onto the crankshaft. The second, third, and forth passes tighten the new bolt to the proper torque. Important: Position the balancer onto the end of the crankshaft as straight as possible prior to tool installation. Install the crankshaft balancer onto the end of the crankshaft. 1. Use J 41665 in order to install the crankshaft balancer. 1. Assemble the threaded rod, nut, washer and installer. Insert the smaller end of the installer into the front of the balancer. 2. Use a wrench and hold the hex end of the threaded rod. 3. Use a second wrench and rotate the installation tool nut clockwise until the balancer is started onto the crankshaft. 4. Remove the tool and reverse the installation tool. Position the larger end of the installer against the front of the balancer. 5. Use a wrench and hold the hex end of the threaded rod. 6. Use a second wrench and rotate the installation tool nut clockwise until the balancer is installed onto the crankshaft. 7. Remove the balancer installation tool. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Install the used crankshaft balancer bolt. Tighten the USED bolt to 330 N.m (240 lb ft). 3. Remove the used crankshaft balancer bolt. Page 1564 Checking Aftermarket Accessories CHECKING AFTERMARKET ACCESSORIES Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits: - CAUTION: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol. - NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice. OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol. Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the cause of the problems. Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include: Power feeds connected to points other than the battery - Antenna location - Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring - Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line - Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories. Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions INDUCING INTERMITTENT FAULT CONDITIONS TOOLS REQUIRED J 25070 Heat Gun Many intermittent open or shorted circuits are affected by harness/connector movement that is caused by vibration, engine torque, bumps/rough pavement, etc. In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness if the malfunction appears to be Service and Repair Crankshaft Main Bearing Seal: Service and Repair Crankshaft Rear Oil Seal Replacement Tools Required J 41479 Crankshaft Rear Oil Seal Installer Removal Procedure 1. Remove the engine flywheel. Refer to Engine Flywheel Replacement. 2. Remove the crankshaft rear oil seal (1) from the rear cover. Installation Procedure Important: ^ Remove the flywheel spacer, if applicable, prior to oil seal installation. ^ Do not lubricate the oil seal inside diameter or the crankshaft surface. ^ Do not reuse the crankshaft rear oil seal. 1. Lubricate the outside diameter of the oil seal (1) with clean engine oil. DO NOT allow oil or other lubricants to contact the seal surface. 2. Lubricate the rear cover oil seal bore with clean engine oil. DO NOT allow oil or other lubricants to contact the crankshaft surface. Page 6071 It is very important to use the correct test adapter when testing for proper terminal contact of fuses and relays in a bussed electrical center (BEC). Use J-35616-35 to test for proper terminal contact. Failure to use J-35616-35 can result in improper diagnosis of the BEC. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Separate the connector halves. 2. Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body. 3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J-38125 , test that the retention force is significantly different between a good terminal and a suspect terminal. Replace the female terminal in question. FLAT WIRE (DOCK AND LOCK) CONNECTORS There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock) connectors on the harness side or the component side. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Remove the component in question. 2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side of the connector as oil from your skin may be a source of contamination as well. 3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other imperfections that could cause poor terminal contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are uniform and free of damage or deformation. 4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the on the flat wire harness connector in order to test the circuit in question. CONTROL MODULE/COMPONENT VOLTAGE AND GROUNDS Poor voltage or ground connections can cause widely varying symptoms. Test all control module voltage supply circuits. Many vehicles have multiple circuits supplying voltage to a control module. Other components in the system may have separate voltage supply circuits that may also need to be tested. Inspect connections at the module/component connectors, fuses, and any intermediate connections between the voltage source and the module/component. A test lamp or a DMM may indicate that voltage is present, but neither tests the ability of the circuit to carry sufficient current. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Power Distribution Schematics. - Test all control module ground and system ground circuits. The control module may have multiple ground circuits. Other components in the system may have separate grounds that may also need to be tested. Inspect grounds for clean and tight connections at the grounding point. Inspect the connections at the component and in splice packs, where applicable. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Ground Distribution Schematics. TEMPERATURE SENSITIVITY - An intermittent condition may occur when a component/connection reaches normal operating temperature. The condition may occur only when the component/connection is cold, or only when the component/connection is hot. - Freeze Frame, Failure Records, Snapshot, or Vehicle Data Recorder data may help with this type of intermittent condition, where applicable. - If the intermittent is related to heat, review the data for a relationship with the following: High ambient temperatures - Underhood/engine generated heat - Circuit generated heat due to a poor connection, or high electrical load - Higher than normal load conditions, towing, etc. - If the intermittent is related to cold, review the data for the following: Low ambient temperatures-In extremely low temperatures, ice may form in a connection or component. Inspect for water intrusion. - The condition only occurs on a cold start. - The condition goes away when the vehicle warms up. - Information from the customer may help to determine if the trouble follows a pattern that is temperature related. - If temperature is suspected of causing an intermittent fault condition, attempt to duplicate the condition. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required. ELECTROMAGNETIC INTERFERENCE (EMI) AND ELECTRICAL NOISE Some electrical components/circuits are sensitive to electromagnetic interference (EMI) or other types of electrical noise. Inspect for the following conditions: A misrouted harness that is too close to high voltage/high current devices such as secondary ignition components, motors, generator etc-These components may induce electrical noise on a circuit that could interfere with normal circuit operation. - Electrical system interference caused by a malfunctioning relay, or a control module driven solenoid or switch-These conditions can cause a sharp electrical surge. Normally, the condition will occur when the malfunctioning component is operating. - Improper installation of non-factory or aftermarket add on accessories such as lights, 2-way radios, amplifiers, electric motors, remote starters, alarm systems, cell phones, etc-These accessories may lead to interference while in use, but do not fail when the accessories are not in use. - Test for an open diode across the A/C compressor clutch and for other open diodes. Some relays may contain a clamping diode. - The generator may be allowing AC noise into the electrical system. INCORRECT CONTROL MODULE - There are only a few situations where reprogramming a control module is appropriate: A new service control module is installed. Page 4918 4. Once the front 2 locks are unlocked, lift the front of the dress cover and pull it forward. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the small slot on the TPA and pushing down until the TPA releases. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to angle or rock the J 38125-21 tool when inserting it into the connector or the tool may break. Insert the J 38125-21 (GM P/N 15381651-2) tool into the round canal between the terminals cavities at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to repair Micro 64 connector terminals. The Micro 64 connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-64 (M jaw) was developed to crimp Micro 64 terminals. The J 38125-64 crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. The J 38125-64 crimping tool is also designed to crimp both the wire and the insulation at the same time. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro 64 terminals. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. 1. Cut the wire as close to the damaged terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. Page 1881 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the TPA. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the nose piece. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. Page 6903 View of the connector when released from the component. View of another type of Micro 64 connector. Page 8588 Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size. REPAIRING A FUSIBLE LINK IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient overload protection. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. Flat Wire Repairs FLAT WIRE REPAIRS NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced. GMLAN Wiring Repairs GMLAN WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The GM Local Area Network (GMLAN) System requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working on GMLAN connectors and terminals. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items in order to repair the GMLAN wiring: Dura Seal splice sleeves - A wire stripping tool - J 38125-8 Crimping Tool (GM P/N 12085115) - J 38125-5 Ultra Torch Special Tool (GM P/N 12085116) The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. - A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors GMLAN REPAIRS IMPORTANT: When making a repair to any GMLAN network, the original wire length after the repair must be the same length as before the repair. If the network is a twisted pair, the twist must be maintained after the repair is completed. GMLAN has 2 types of networks, low speed and high speed. Low speed GMLAN has a single wire and works at slow speeds. High speed GMLAN has 2 wires in a twisted pair and works at higher speeds. For more information on GMLAN, refer to Data Link Communications Description and Operation. GMLAN CONNECTOR TERMINAL REPAIR IMPORTANT: A service terminal can be used to replace damaged connector terminals for both high speed and low speed GMLAN systems. When making a connector terminal repair on a GMLAN high speed system with twisted pair wires, do not untwist the wires more than necessary to make the repair. The terminals in the GMLAN system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are available in the J-38125. If the individual terminals are damaged on any GMLAN connection, use the appropriate connector repair procedure in order to repair the terminal. GMLAN WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 3713 Valve Deactivation Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids Arrows and Symbols Arrows and Symbols This Service Data uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations. Arrows and Symbols 1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow Basic Knowledge Required GENERAL ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures contained in the service manual. You should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current (amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram, as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. Decimal and Metric Equivalents Decimal and Metric Equivalents Valve Rocker Arm Cover Replacement - Left Side Valve Cover: Service and Repair Valve Rocker Arm Cover Replacement - Left Side Valve Rocker Arm Cover Replacement - Left Side Removal Procedure 1. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) lock. 2. Disconnect the main electrical connector (5) to the ignition coil wire harness. 3. Remove the harness clips. 4. Reposition the engine harness, if necessary. 5. Remove the spark plug wires from the ignition coils. ^ Twist each plug wire 1/2 turn. ^ Pull only on the boot in order to remove the wire from the ignition coil. 6. If necessary, remove the ignition coil bracket studs from the rocker arm cover. Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 04-06-04-054B Date: November 18, 2010 Subject: Info - Non-GM Parts and Accessories (Aftermarket) Models: 2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years and update to the new U.S. Fixed Operation Manager (FOM) and Canada Warranty Manager (WM) names. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 04-06-04-054A (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). The recent rise and expansion of companies selling non-GM parts and accessories has made it necessary to issue this reminder to dealers regarding GM's policy on the use and installation of these aftermarket components. When a dealer is performing a repair under the New Vehicle Limited Warranty, they are required to use only genuine GM or GM-approved parts and accessories. This applies to all warranty repairs, special policy repairs or any repairs paid for by GM. Parts and accessories advertised as being "the same" as parts manufactured by GM, but not sold through GM, do not qualify for use in warranty repairs, special policy repairs or any repairs paid for by GM. During a warranty repair, if a GM original equipment part is not available through GM Customer Care and Aftersales (GM CC&A;), ACDelco(R) distributors, other GM dealers or approved sources, the dealer is to obtain comparable, non-GM parts and clearly indicate, in detail, on the repair order the circumstances surrounding why non-GM parts were used. The dealer must give customers written notice, prior to the sale or service, that such parts or accessories are not marketed or warranted by General Motors. It should also be noted that dealers modifying new vehicles and installing equipment, parts and accessories obtained from sources not authorized by GM are responsible for complying with the National Traffic and Motor Vehicle Safety Act. Certain non-approved parts or assemblies, installed by the dealer or its agent not authorized by GM, may result in a change to the vehicle's design characteristics and may affect the vehicle's ability to conform to federal law. Dealers must fully understand that non-GM approved parts may not have been validated, tested or certified for use. This puts the dealer at risk for potential liability in the event of a part or vehicle failure. If a GM part failure occurs as the result of the installation or use of a non-GM approved part, the warranty will not be honored. A good example of non-authorized modification of vehicles is the result of an ever increasing supply of aftermarket devices available to the customer, which claim to increase the horsepower and torque of the Duramax(TM) Diesel Engines. These include the addition of, but are not limited to one or more of the following modifications: - Propane injection - Nitrous oxide injection - Additional modules (black boxes) that connect to the vehicle wiring systems - Revised engine calibrations downloaded for the engine control module - Calibration modules which connect to the vehicle diagnostic connector - Modification to the engine turbocharger waste gate Although the installation of these devices, or modification of vehicle components, can increase engine horsepower and torque, they may also negatively affect the engine emissions, reliability and/or durability. In addition, other powertrain components, such as transmissions, universal joints, drive shafts, and front/rear axle components, can be stressed beyond design safety limits by the installation of these devices. General Motors does not support or endorse the use of devices or modifications that, when installed, increase the engine horsepower and torque. It is because of these unknown stresses, and the potential to alter reliability, durability and emissions performance, that GM has adopted a policy that prevents any UNAUTHORIZED dealer warranty claim submissions to any remaining warranty coverage, to the powertrain and driveline components whenever the presence of a non-GM (aftermarket) calibration is confirmed - even if the non-GM control module calibration is subsequently removed. Refer to the latest version of Bulletin 09-06-04-026 (V8 Gas Engines) or 06-06-01-007 (Duramax(TM) Diesel Engines) for more information on dealer requirements for calibration verification. These same policies apply as they relate to the use of non-GM accessories. Damage or failure from the use or installation of a non-GM accessory will not be covered under warranty. Failure resulting from the alteration or modification of the vehicle, including the cutting, welding or disconnecting of the vehicle's original equipment parts and components will void the warranty. Additionally, dealers will NOT be reimbursed or compensated by GM in the event of any legal inquiry at either the local, state or federal level that Page 1932 Page 6543 6. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs located on the opposite side of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover at the connector end and pry up. 7. Remove the dress cover. 8. Cut the tie wrap on the wire bundle. 9. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting a small flat-bladed tool into the small slot in the end of the slider and pushing on the TPA until it comes out of the connector. When the TPA exits the opposite side of the connector, gasp the TPA and pull it completely out of the connector. 10. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 8289 MOLEX CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. 2. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. Page 3385 2. Locate the nose piece locking tabs that are positioned on the side of the connector nose piece. The connector nose piece acts as a terminal positive assurance (TPA) and may be referred to as such. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to push in one of the locking tabs while gently pulling on the same side of the nose piece. 4. Repeat the procedure for the other locking tab and remove the nose piece. 5. Remove the wire dress cover. The following is a general procedure for wire dress cover removal. Use this procedure as a guide, some dress cover removal procedures may vary. 6. Use fingers to squeeze the 2 locking legs of the cover. Locations Steering Wheel And Column Engine - Valve Lifter Tick Noise At Start Up Lifter / Lash Adjuster: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Valve Lifter Tick Noise At Start Up TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 10-06-01-007C Date: February 09, 2011 Subject: Active Fuel Management (AFM) Engine, Valve Lifter Tick Noise at Start Up When Engine Has Been Off for 2 Hours or More (Evaluate Noise and/or Replace Valve Lifters) Models: 2007 Buick Rainier 2009 Buick LaCrosse Super, Allure Super (Canada Only) 2007 Cadillac Escalade Built Prior to April 1, 2006 with 6.2L Engine RPO L92 (These engines were built with AFM Hardware but the AFM system was disabled) 2010-2011 Cadillac Escalade, Escalade ESV, Escalade EXT 2007 Chevrolet Monte Carlo 2007-2009 Chevrolet Impala 2007-2011 Chevrolet Avalanche, Silverado, Suburban, Tahoe, TrailBlazer, TrailBlazer EXT 2010-2011 Chevrolet Camaro SS 2007-2011 GMC Envoy, Envoy XL, Sierra, Yukon, Yukon Denali, Yukon XL, Yukon XL Denali 2007-2008 Pontiac Grand Prix 2008-2009 Pontiac G8 2007-2009 Saab 9-7X Equipped with AFM (Active Fuel Management) and V8 Engine RPO L76, L94, L99, LC9, LFA, LH6, LMG, LS4, LY5 or LZ1 Attention: This bulletin only applies to the AFM V8 engines listed above. It DOES NOT apply to Non-AFM Engines. If you are dealing with a Non-AFM engine that is experiencing a similar noise, please refer to Engine Mechanical > Diagnostic Information and Procedures > Symptoms in SI. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add models. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 10-06-01-007B (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). Condition Some customers may comment on an engine valve lifter tick noise that occurs after the engine has been shut off for at least two hours. The tick noise may last from two seconds to ten minutes. Cause This condition may be caused by any of the following: - Aerated oil in the valve lifter body, resulting in the valve lifter being unable to purge the air quickly. - A low engine oil level or incorrect oil viscosity. - Dirty or contaminated oil. - A low internal valve lifter oil reservoir level. - Debris in the valve lifter. - A high valve lifter leak down rate. Correction If the SI diagnostics do not isolate the cause of this valve lifter tick noise and normal oil pressure is noted during the concern, perform the following steps: 1. Inspect the engine oil condition and level. Refer to Owner Manual > Service and Appearance Care > Checking Things Under the Hood > Description and Operation > Engine Oil in SI. ‹› If the engine oil is more than one quart low, an incorrect oil viscosity is being used or if poor quality/contamination is observed, change the oil and filter. Note Page 2917 Spark Plug: Service and Repair Spark Plug Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Remove the spark plug wire. 2. Remove the washer solvent container to gain access to the #2 spark plug. 3. Loosen the spark plug 1-2 turns. 4. Brush or using compressed air, blow away any dirt from around the spark plug. 5. Remove the spark plug. If removing more than one plug, place each plug in a tray marked with the corresponding cylinder number. Installation Procedure Page 6870 All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system. Page 6481 Release the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the blue locking tabs on both ends of the connector. Gently slide the TPA up to the released position on both ends. 6. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-13A (GM P/N 12031876-1) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. Page 8852 breakers are used. CIRCUIT BREAKER This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high current is removed. POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) CIRCUIT BREAKER This type greatly increases its resistance when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker will re-close within a second or 2. Circuit Protection - Fuses CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSES The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and examine the element in the fuse for an open (2). If not broken (1), also check for continuity using a DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one of equal current rating. Circuit Protection - Fusible Links CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSIBLE LINKS Page 1133 Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Locations Engine Controls Component Views Left Side of Engine - Front 1 - Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor 2 - G108 Engine - Noise/Damage Oil Filter Application Importance Oil Filter: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Noise/Damage Oil Filter Application Importance INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 07-06-01-016B Date: July 27, 2009 Subject: Information on Internal Engine Noise or Damage After Oil Filter Replacement Models: 2010 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X Supercede: This bulletin is being updated to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 07-06-01-016A (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). Important Engine damage that is the result of an incorrect or improperly installed engine oil filter is not a warrantable claim. The best way to avoid oil filter quality concerns is to purchase ACDelco(R) oil filters directly from GMSPO. Oil filter misapplication may cause abnormal engine noise or internal damage. Always utilize the most recent parts information to ensure the correct part number filter is installed when replacing oil filters. Do not rely on physical dimensions alone. Counterfeit copies of name brand parts have been discovered in some aftermarket parts systems. Always ensure the parts you install are from a trusted source. Improper oil filter installation may result in catastrophic engine damage. Refer to the appropriate Service Information (SI) installation instructions when replacing any oil filter and pay particular attention to procedures for proper cartridge filter element alignment. If the diagnostics in SI (Engine Mechanical) lead to the oil filter as the cause of the internal engine noise or damage, dealers should submit a field product report. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 02-00-89-002I (Information for Dealers on How to Submit a Field Product Report). Disclaimer Page 5522 Page 5894 Page 3406 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry one side of the nose piece up to the pre-stage position. When the nose piece is in the pre-staged position, the nose piece will be raised above the connector body the length of the step in the nose piece. 7. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry the other side of the piece to the pre-stage position. If the nose piece is higher than the first step in the nose piece, gently push down on the nose piece until it meets with resistance from the connector body, you should feel the nose piece click into position. Aluminum Wheel Porosity Repair Wheels: Service and Repair Aluminum Wheel Porosity Repair Aluminum Wheel Porosity Repair 1. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 2. Remove the tire and wheel. Refer to Tire and Wheel Removal and Installation. 3. Inflate the tire to the manufacturer specified pressure as stated on the tire. 4. Submerge the tire/wheel into a water bath in order to locate the leak. 5. Inscribe a mark on the wheel in order to indicate the leak areas. 6. Inscribe a mark on the tire at the valve stem in order to indicate the orientation of the tire to the wheel. 7. Remove the tire from the wheel. Refer to Tire Mounting and Dismounting. Important: Do not damage the exterior surface of the wheel. 8. Use number 80 grit sandpaper to scuff the inside of the rim surface at the leak area. 9. Use general purpose cleaner such as 3M(R), P/N 08984 or equivalent, to clean the leak area. 10. Apply 3 mm (0.12 in) thick layer of adhesive/sealant, GM P/N 1052366 or equivalent, to the leak area. 11. Allow for the adhesive/sealant to dry. 12. Align the inscribed mark on the tire with the valve stem on the wheel. 13. Install the tire to the wheel. Refer to Tire Mounting and Dismounting. 14. Inflate the tire to the manufacturer specified pressure as stated on the tire. 15. Submerge the tire/wheel into a water bath in order ensure the leak is sealed. 16. Balance the tire and wheel. Refer to Tire and Wheel Assembly Balancing - Off Vehicle. 17. Install the tire and wheel. Refer to Tire and Wheel Removal and Installation. 18. Lower the vehicle. Page 6278 US English/Metric Conversion US English/Metric Conversion Page 8582 View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. View of the release tool being used for the smaller terminals. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (2-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 6207 11. Insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) into the 2 triangular cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 12. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE 1. Prior to installation the terminal must be aligned so the (1) coding lugs align with the (2) coding grooves on the connector. 2. Once the terminal is aligned, slide the terminal into the cavity until the retainer has engaged in the cavity of the connector. 3. Slide the TPA in the connector body and seat it using a small flat bladed tool. The TPA is seated when it is flush with the contact housing. 4. Secure the wires to the connector body using a tie wrap and replace the dress cover and grommet. Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) BOSCH CONNECTORS (2.8 JPT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Pull out the slider on the connector position assurance (CPA) until it is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 1282 Turn Signal Switch: Service and Repair Turn Signal Multifunction Switch Replacement Turn Signal Multifunction Switch Replacement Removal Procedure Caution: Refer to SIR Caution. 1. Disable the SIR system. Refer to SIR Disabling and Enabling. 2. Remove the upper and lower trim covers. Refer to Steering Column Trim Covers Replacement. 3. Tilt the column to the CENTER position. 4. Disconnect the connectors from the turn signal and multifunction switch assembly. 5. Remove 2 pan head tapping screws from the turn signal and multifunction switch assembly. 6. Remove the turn signal and multifunction switch assembly. Installation Procedure Important: The electrical contact on the turn signal and multifunction switch assembly must rest on the turn signal cancel cam assembly. 1. Install the turn signal and multifunction switch assembly. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Secure by using 2 pan head tapping screws. ^ Tighten the screw on the top of the column to 3 N.m (27 lb in). ^ Tighten the screw on the side to 7 N.m (62 lb in). 3. Connect the connectors to the turn signal and multifunction switch assembly. 4. Install the upper and lower trim covers. Refer to Steering Column Trim Covers Replacement. 5. Enable the SIR system. Refer to SIR Disabling and Enabling. Page 7821 Release the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the blue locking tabs on both ends of the connector. Gently slide the TPA up to the released position on both ends. 6. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-13A (GM P/N 12031876-1) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. Diagram Information and Instructions Valve Deactivation Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions Electrical Symbols Page 8288 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the rear TPA from the connector. 7. IMPORTANT: The front TPA cannot be removed from the connector. Only move it to the release point. Use a small flat-blade tool to move the front TPA to the release position. 8. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 9. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Molex Connectors Page 1959 Page 2223 Connector Anatomy Connector Repairs contains a list of all connector repairs. The connector repairs are listed by the connector manufacturer and then by connector type. If the technician cannot identify the manufacturer of the connector, refer to Identifying Connectors below. Knowing the connector manufacturer will assist in finding the correct connector repair from the following list: - Connector Position Assurance Locks - Terminal Position Assurance Locks - Bosch Connectors (0.64) Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) Bosch Connectors (BSK) Bosch Connectors (ECM) - Delphi Connectors (Micro.64) Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) Delphi Connectors (12-Way) - Tyco/AMP Connectors (CM 42-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) Tyco/AMP Connectors (025 Cap) Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) - Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) - Repairing Connector Terminals IDENTIFYING CONNECTORS Knowing the connector manufacturer is helpful when trying to locating the correct connector repair procedure. There are many different connector designs used on GM vehicles and it is sometimes difficult to identify the connector manufacturer. The information in this document should help with the identification of connector manufactures. The following connector manufacturers make most of the connectors found in GM vehicles: AFL/EPC (Alcoa Fujikura Ltd./Engineered Plastics Components) - Bosch - Delphi - FCI (Framatome Connectors International) - JAE (Japan Aviation Electronics) - JST (Japan Solderless Terminals) Page 4366 Checking Aftermarket Accessories CHECKING AFTERMARKET ACCESSORIES Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits: - CAUTION: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol. - NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice. OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol. Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the cause of the problems. Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include: Power feeds connected to points other than the battery - Antenna location - Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring - Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line - Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories. Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions INDUCING INTERMITTENT FAULT CONDITIONS TOOLS REQUIRED J 25070 Heat Gun Many intermittent open or shorted circuits are affected by harness/connector movement that is caused by vibration, engine torque, bumps/rough pavement, etc. In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness if the malfunction appears to be Page 5713 View of typical connector. View of connector in released position. 1. Locate the assist lever at the back of the connector. Move the assist lever to the rear position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the dress cover. Page 6825 1. Install the MAF/IAT sensor (3) to the air filter element (6). 2. Install the air filter element (6) and MAF/IAT sensor (3) to the lower air cleaner housing/washer solvent tank assembly (4). Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. Important: Ensure the air inlet duct (5) is properly positioned in the lower air cleaner housing/washer solvent tank assembly (4) before installing the air cleaner cover (2). 3. Install the air cleaner cover (2) and secure with 4 retaining screws (1). Tighten the screws to 4 N.m (35 lb in). 4. Install the radiator support diagonal brace. 5. Connect the MAF/IAT sensor electrical connector (1). 6. Install the air cleaner outlet duct. Page 6557 The first connector design of the Micro-Pack 100W (1) has a white connector interface that holds the terminals. The second design of the Micro-Pack 100W (2) has a gray interface to hold the terminals. Also, the first design has terminal cavities that are further apart (3 mm centerline) and offset from the other row of terminal cavities in the connector. The second design has terminals cavities that are closer together (2.54 mm centerline) and aligned vertically. One other way to identify the second design is the thin strip of material that runs along the outside of the cavities. IMPORTANT: There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W terminals which are very similar. Ensure that you have the correct terminal before crimping the new terminal to the wire. The first design connector uses the longer terminal (1) that has a raised area in front of the recess in the terminal. The second design connector uses the shorter terminal without the raised area. Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro-Pack 100W connectors. Some Micro-Pack 100W connector disassembly procedures will vary. Use this procedure as a guide. 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 8469 Crankshaft Position Sensor: Connector Views Engine Controls Connector End Views Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON Air Filter Element: Customer Interest Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-013B Date: February 01, 2007 INFORMATION Subject: Automatic Transmission Shift, Engine Driveability Concerns or Service Engine Soon (SES) Light On as a Result of the Use of an Excessively/Over-Oiled Aftermarket, Reusable Air Filter Models: 2007 and Prior GM Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2007 and Prior Saturn Models 2003-2007 HUMMER H2 2006-2007 HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 04-07-30-013A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle). The use of an excessively/over-oiled aftermarket, reusable air filter may result in: Service Engine Soon (SES) light on Transmission shift concerns, slipping and damaged clutch(es) or band(s) Engine driveability concerns, poor acceleration from a stop, limited engine RPM range The oil that is used on these air filter elements may be transferred onto the Mass Air Flow (MAF) sensor causing contamination of the sensor. As a result, the Grams per Second (GPS) signal from the MAF may be low and any or all of the concerns listed above may occur. When servicing a vehicle with any of these concerns, be sure to check for the presence of an aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter. The MAF, GPS reading should be compared to a like vehicle with an OEM air box and filter under the same driving conditions to verify the concern. The use of an aftermarket reusable air filter DOES NOT void the vehicle's warranty. If an aftermarket reusable air filter is used, technicians should inspect the MAF sensor element and the air induction hose for contamination of oil prior to making warranty repairs. Transmission or engine driveability concerns (related to the MAF sensor being contaminated with oil) that are the result of the use of an aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter are not considered to be warrantable repair items. Page 6741 If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the DuraSeal splice sleeves. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: - Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. - Do not use the crimp and DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 to crimp DuraSeal splice sleeve. In order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 7577 Information Bus: Description and Operation DATA LINK COMMUNICATIONS DESCRIPTION AND OPERATION DATA LINK CONNECTOR (DLC) The data link connector (DLC) is a standardized 16 cavity connector. Connector design and location is dictated by an industry wide standard, and is required to provide the following: Scan tool power battery positive voltage at terminal 16 - Scan tool power ground at terminal 4 - Common signal ground at terminal 5 - Class 2 signal at terminal 2 - High speed GMLAN serial data bus (+) at terminal 6, w/5.3L - High speed GMLAN serial data bus (-) at terminal 14, w/5.3L CLASS 2 CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION The data link connector (DLC) allows a scan tool to communicate with the class 2 serial data circuit. Class 2 serial data is transmitted on a single wire at an average of 10.4 Kbps. The bus is active at 7.0 volts nominal and inactive at ground potential. Each module communicating on the class 2 serial data line sends a state of health (SOH) message every 2 seconds to ensure that the module is operating properly. When a module stops communicating on the class 2 serial data line, for example if the module loses power or ground, the SOH message it normally sends on the data line every 2 seconds disappears. Other modules on the class 2 serial data line, which expect to receive that SOH message, detect its absence; those modules in turn set an internal DTC associated with the loss of SOH of the non-communicating module. The DTC is unique to the module which is not communicating, for example, when the body control module (BCM) SOH message disappears, several modules set DTC U1064. Note that a loss of serial data DTC does not normally represent a failure of the module that set it. The class 2 serial data line on this vehicle is a star configuration. The powertrain control module (PCM) has an additional class 2 serial data circuit to BCM or to theft deterrent control module, if equipped. If one of the class 2 serial data circuits to the PCM opens, communication will not be interrupted. The following modules communicate on the class 2 serial data line: The BCM - The communication interface module (OnStar(R)), w/UE1 - The digital radio receiver (DRR), w/U2K - The driver door module (DDM) - The driver seat module (DSM), w/AAB - The DVD player - The electronic brake control module (EBCM) - The engine control module (ECM), w/5.3L - The HVAC control module - The HVAC control module - rear auxiliary - The inflatable restraint sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) - The instrument panel cluster (IPC) - The liftgate control module (LGM) - The passenger door module (PDM) - The powertrain control module (PCM), w/4.2L - The radio - The transfer case shift control module (TCSCM), w/4WD - The theft deterrent control module (VTD), w/BAE The class 2 serial data line allows a scan tool to communicate with these modules for testing purposes, checking for DTCs, and to activate/enable/disable functions. These class 2 serial data circuits are bused together via 2 splice packs: SP205-Located behind the instrument panel (I/P) near the headlamp switch connector - SP306-Located in the body harness near the rear of the right rear seat under the carpet GMLAN CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION (W/5.3L) The data link connector (DLC) allows a scan tool to communicate with the high speed GMLAN serial data circuit. The serial data is transmitted on two twisted wires that allow speed up to 500 Kbps. The twisted pair is terminated with two 120 ohm resistors, one is internal to the engine control module (ECM) and the other is nearby the DLC. The resistors are used to reduce noise on the high speed GMLAN bus during normal vehicle operation. The high speed GMLAN is a differential bus. The high speed GMLAN serial data bus (+) and high speed GMLAN serial data (-) are driven to opposite extremes from a rest or idle level. The idle level which is approximately 2.5 volts is considered a recessive transmitted data and is interpreted as a logic 1. Driving the lines to their extremes adds 1 volt to high speed GMLAN serial data bus (+) and subtracts 1 volt from high speed GMLAN serial data bus (-) wire. This dominant state is interpreted as a logic 0. The signal supervision is the process of determining whether an expected signal is being received or not. Failsofting is the ability to substitute a signal with a default value or a default algorithm, in the absence of a valid signal. Some messages are also interpreted as a "heartbeat" of a virtual device. If such a signal is lost, the application will set a no communication code against the respective virtual device. Note that a loss of serial data DTC does not normally represent a failure of the module that set it. The following modules are connected to the high speed GMLAN serial data communication circuits: Page 6824 Air Filter Element: Service and Repair Air Cleaner Element Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Remove the air cleaner outlet duct. 2. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF)/intake air temperature (IAT) sensor electrical connector (1). 3. Remove the radiator support diagonal brace. 4. Loosen the 4 air cleaner cover retaining screws (1). 5. Remove the air cleaner housing cover (2). Lift and rotate the cover in order to remove the cover from the vehicle. 6. Remove the air filter element (6) and the MAF/IAT sensor (3) from the lower air cleaner housing/washer solvent tank assembly (4). 7. Separate the air filter element (6) from the MAF/IAT sensor (3). 8. Inspect the entire assembly for dust, debris, or water. Clean or replace as necessary. Installation Procedure Page 6946 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert a small flat-blade tool in the slot below the front loaded terminal position assurance (TPA) and pry up. 3. Remove the TPA by pulling it out of the connector. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-553 (GM P/N 15315247) on a slight upward angle into the cavity below the terminal to be removed. Ensure that the pointed on the end of the tool is facing the bottom of the terminal and it stays in contact with the terminal until it stops on the plastic terminal retainer. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 8702 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the rear TPA from the connector. 7. IMPORTANT: The front TPA cannot be removed from the connector. Only move it to the release point. Use a small flat-blade tool to move the front TPA to the release position. 8. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 9. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Molex Connectors Page 227 View of typical connector. View of connector in released position. 1. Locate the assist lever at the back of the connector. Move the assist lever to the rear position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the dress cover. Page 5162 3. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. View showing depressing of the lever lock release tab. Page 1584 11. Insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) into the 2 triangular cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 12. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE 1. Prior to installation the terminal must be aligned so the (1) coding lugs align with the (2) coding grooves on the connector. 2. Once the terminal is aligned, slide the terminal into the cavity until the retainer has engaged in the cavity of the connector. 3. Slide the TPA in the connector body and seat it using a small flat bladed tool. The TPA is seated when it is flush with the contact housing. 4. Secure the wires to the connector body using a tie wrap and replace the dress cover and grommet. Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) BOSCH CONNECTORS (2.8 JPT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Pull out the slider on the connector position assurance (CPA) until it is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 6119 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry one side of the nose piece up to the pre-stage position. When the nose piece is in the pre-staged position, the nose piece will be raised above the connector body the length of the step in the nose piece. 7. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry the other side of the piece to the pre-stage position. If the nose piece is higher than the first step in the nose piece, gently push down on the nose piece until it meets with resistance from the connector body, you should feel the nose piece click into position. Diagram Information and Instructions Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions Electrical Symbols Page 7236 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link). - The wire insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. 5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold them between thumb and forefinger. 7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place. - Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction. - Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip. 8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool closes.Ensure that no strands of wire are cut. 10. Crimp the splice on each end (2). Page 4601 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. 4. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front of the connector. Page 170 Page 9035 View of the connector when released from the component. View of another type of Micro 64 connector. Page 2381 5. While pushing the terminal forward, insert the J 38125-24 in the release cavity above the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (43-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Page 4478 IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals. Front probe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the connector. IMPORTANT: When probing female 0.64 terminals, it is important to use the correct adapter. There have been some revisions to the test adapter for 0.64 terminals. The proper adapter for 0.64 terminals is the J 35616-64B which has a gold terminal and a black wire between the base and tip. Failure to use the proper test adapter may result in damage to the terminal being tested and improper diagnosis. NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Page 7970 Engine Control Module: Locations Engine Controls Component Views Engine Control Module (ECM) 1 - Engine Control Module (ECM) 2 - Engine Control Module (ECM) C3 3 - Engine Control Module (ECM) C2 4 - Engine Control Module (ECM) C1 Page 580 Blower Motor Control Processor Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Remove the right closeout panel. 2. Disconnect the electrical connector from the blower motor. 3. Disconnect the electrical connector (3) from the blower motor control processor (1). 4. Remove the blower motor control processor mounting screws (2). 5. Remove the blower motor control processor (1). Installation Procedure 1. Install the blower motor control processor (1). Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Install the blower motor control processor mounting screws (2). Tighten the screws to 1.9 N.m (17 lb in). 3. Connect the electrical connector (3) to the blower motor control processor (1). 4. Connect the electrical connector to the blower motor. 5. Install the right closeout panel. Page 4671 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link). - The wire insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. 5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold them between thumb and forefinger. 7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place. - Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction. - Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip. 8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool closes.Ensure that no strands of wire are cut. 10. Crimp the splice on each end (2). Page 3519 Tire Pressure Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Tires - Minimizing Damage to TPM Sensors INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 08-03-10-007 Date: May 16, 2008 Subject: Minimizing Damage to Tire Pressure Monitor (TPM) Sensors During Tire Mounting/Dismounting Models: 2009 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2009 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X with Wheel Mounted Tire Pressure Sensors Minimizing Damage To TPM Sensors All GM vehicles now in production and sold in the U.S., as well as many vehicles sold in Canada, feature Tire Pressure Monitoring Systems that have valve stem mounted Tire Pressure Sensors. When dismounting and mounting tires, care must be taken when breaking the bead loose from the wheel. If the tire machines bead breaking fixture is positioned too close to the tire pressure sensor, as the tire bead breaks away from the wheel it may be forced into, or catch on the edge of the tire pressure sensor. This can damage the sensor and require the sensor to be replaced. Care must also be taken when transferring the tire bead to the other side of the wheel rim. As the tire machine rotates and the tire bead is stretched around the wheel rim, the bead can come in contact with the sensor if it is not correctly positioned in relation to the mounting/dismounting head prior to tire mounting/dismounting. This can also cause sensor damage requiring replacement. Procedure Notice: Use a tire changing machine in order to dismount tires. Do not use hand tools or tire irons alone in order to remove the tire from the wheel. Damage to the tire beads or the wheel rim could result. Notice: Do not scratch or damage the clear coating on aluminum wheels with the tire changing equipment. Scratching the clear coating could cause the aluminum wheel to corrode and the clear coating to peel from the wheel. 1. Remove the valve core from the valve stem. 2. Deflate the tire completely. Important: Rim-clamp European-type tire changers are recommended. 3. Use the tire changer in order to remove the tire from the wheel. Follow steps 4-7 to remove the tire from the wheel. 4. When separating the tire bead from the wheel position the bead breaking fixture 90, 180 and 270 degrees from the valve stem. Page 6495 If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the DuraSeal splice sleeves. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: - Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. - Do not use the crimp and DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 to crimp DuraSeal splice sleeve. In order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 1655 US English/Metric Conversion US English/Metric Conversion Page 1925 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link). - The wire insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. 5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold them between thumb and forefinger. 7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place. - Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction. - Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip. 8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool closes.Ensure that no strands of wire are cut. 10. Crimp the splice on each end (2). Locations Power Window Switch: Locations Driver Door Module (DDM) Page 2185 7. Connect the MAF/IAT electrical connector. Page 4562 11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the solder equipment. 12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. 13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to cover the first piece of tape. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE SLEEVES TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit IMPORTANT: Use only dura seal splice sleeves. Other splice sleeves may not protect the splice from moisture or provide a good electrical connection. Use duraseal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. Use duraseal splice sleeves where there is special requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire using duraseal splice sleeves. Page 3966 11. Remove the gasket (1) from the rocker cover. 12. Discard the OLD gasket. Installation Procedure Important: ^ All gasket surfaces should be free of oil and/or other foreign material during assembly. ^ DO NOT reuse the valve rocker arm cover gasket. ^ The valve rocker arm cover bolt grommets may be reused. ^ If the PCV valve grommet has been removed from the rocker cover, install a NEW grommet during assembly. Install a NEW rocker cover gasket (1) into the groove of the valve rocker arm cover. Page 6965 US English/Metric Conversion US English/Metric Conversion Page 7803 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the rear TPA from the connector. 7. IMPORTANT: The front TPA cannot be removed from the connector. Only move it to the release point. Use a small flat-blade tool to move the front TPA to the release position. 8. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 9. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Molex Connectors Page 670 Page 898 11. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 12. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 13. Center the high temperature SCT1 shrink tube over the DuraSeal splice sleeve. 14. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the high temperature heat shrink tubing. 15. Gradually move the heat from the center to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 16. Replace any reflective tape and clips that may have been remove during the repair. Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation REPAIRING DAMAGED WIRE INSULATION Wire Size Conversion Page 4315 7. Remove the inlet hose from the water pump. 8. Using the J 38185, reposition the outlet hose clamp at the water pump. 9. Remove the outlet hose from the water pump. 10. Remove the auxiliary heater inlet and outlet hose/pipe nut. 11. Using the J 38185, reposition the throttle body hose clamp at the throttle body. 12. Remove the hose from the throttle body. 13. Using the J 38185, reposition the auxiliary heater inlet and outlet hose/pipe clamps at the water pump. 14. Remove the inlet and outlet hoses/pipes from the water pump. Page 979 7. Connect the ECM electrical connector (1) to the TCM (2) if previously removed. 8. Install the ECM/TCM cover (2) to the ECM/TCM bracket (1). 9. Ensure the ECM/TCM cover retainers (2) are fully engaged with the ECM/TCM bracket (1). 10. Connect the cooling fan electrical connector. 11. Connect the negative battery cable. Refer to Battery Negative Cable Disconnection and Connection. 12. If the TCM was replaced the replacement TCM must be programmed. Refer to Control Module References. Page 505 The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors. 1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position. 4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool J 38125-10A (GM P/N 12014012-1) into the front (mating end) of the connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal through the back of the connector (2). IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector. 6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. 7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily. 10. Perform system check. Delphi Connectors (12 Way) DELPHI CONNECTORS (12-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. Page 2138 View of typical connector. View of connector in released position. 1. Locate the assist lever at the back of the connector. Move the assist lever to the rear position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the dress cover. Engine - MIL ON P0116/P1400 Set In Very Cold Temps Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - MIL ON P0116/P1400 Set In Very Cold Temps TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 10-06-04-008A Date: January 24, 2011 Subject: Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) Illuminated at Very Cold Ambient Temperatures When Using Engine Coolant Heater, DTC P0116 and/or P1400 Set (Relocate Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor and Engine Coolant Heater Cord) Models: 2006-2007 Buick Rainier 2009 Buick LaCrosse Super, Allure Super (Canada Only) 2006-2010 Cadillac Escalade 2006-2007 Chevrolet Monte Carlo 2006-2009 Chevrolet Impala SS, TrailBlazer 2006-2010 Chevrolet Avalanche, Express, Silverado Tahoe 2006-2009 GMC Envoy 2006-2010 GMC Savana, Sierra, Yukon 2006-2008 Pontiac Grand Prix 2006-2009 Saab 9-7X Equipped with V8 Engine RPO LC9, LH6, LH8, LH9, L76, LS2, LS4, LFA, LZ1, L92, L94, L9H or L20, L96, LMF, LMG, LY2, LY5, LY6 Please Refer to GMVIS Attention: To properly correct this condition, you must follow both of the procedures to relocate the ECT sensor and the engine coolant heater cord. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add cast iron block engine RPOs and to update the Warranty Information coverage period. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 10-06-04-008 (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). Condition Some customers may comment that the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) illuminates after starting the vehicle when they were using the engine coolant heater in very cold ambient temperatures. This usually occurs in a range of -23 to -40°C (-10 to -40°F) or colder. The technician may observe on a scan tool DTC P0116 and/or P1400 set as Current or in History. Cause This condition may be caused by the engine control module (ECM) determining that the ignition OFF time requirement has been met at start-up and interpreting the temperature difference between the engine coolant temperature (ECT) sensor and the intake air temperature (IAT) sensor as being outside of a calibrated range. Correction Important DO NOT replace the ECM for this condition. Relocating the ECT Sensor 1. Turn ON the ignition with the engine OFF. 2. Perform the diagnostic system check - vehicle. Refer to Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle in SI. ‹› If DTC P0116 and/or P1400 are set and the customer WAS using the engine coolant heater, proceed to Step 3. ‹› If DTC P0116 and/or P1400 are set and the customer WAS NOT using the engine coolant heater, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle in SI. 3. Turn OFF the ignition. Warning To avoid being burned, do not remove the radiator cap or surge tank cap while the engine is hot. The cooling system will release scalding fluid and steam Page 2275 2. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully push the terminal position assurance (TPA) towards the face of the connector on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA is fragile and may break if not done carefully. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. 3. Use the J 38125-215 tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 7676 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert a small flat-blade tool in the slot below the front loaded terminal position assurance (TPA) and pry up. 3. Remove the TPA by pulling it out of the connector. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-553 (GM P/N 15315247) on a slight upward angle into the cavity below the terminal to be removed. Ensure that the pointed on the end of the tool is facing the bottom of the terminal and it stays in contact with the terminal until it stops on the plastic terminal retainer. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 7103 Page 7010 Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Inflatable Restraint Front End Sensor Replacement Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Inflatable Restraint Front End Sensor Replacement Inflatable Restraint Front End Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure Caution: Do not strike or jolt the inflatable restraint front end sensor. Before applying power to the front end sensor make sure that it is securely fastened. Failure to observe the correct installation procedure could cause SIR deployment, personal injury, or unnecessary SIR system repairs. Caution: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. 1. Disable the SIR system. Refer to SIR Disabling and Enabling. 2. Remove the grille. 3. Remove the headlamp wire harness from the retaining clip (1). 4. Raise and support the headlamp wire harness (1) to gain access to the front end sensor. 5. Loosen the bolts (1) retaining the sensor to the frame. 6. Remove the sensor assembly from the frame (1). Page 5833 2. Locate the nose piece locking tabs that are positioned on the side of the connector nose piece. The connector nose piece acts as a terminal positive assurance (TPA) and may be referred to as such. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to push in one of the locking tabs while gently pulling on the same side of the nose piece. 4. Repeat the procedure for the other locking tab and remove the nose piece. 5. Remove the wire dress cover. The following is a general procedure for wire dress cover removal. Use this procedure as a guide, some dress cover removal procedures may vary. 6. Use fingers to squeeze the 2 locking legs of the cover. Page 973 Control Module: Diagrams Transmission Control Module (TCM), Engine Side (5.3L and 6.0L) Transmission Control Module (TCM), Engine Side Page 8850 2. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully push the terminal position assurance (TPA) towards the face of the connector on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA is fragile and may break if not done carefully. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. 3. Use the J 38125-215 tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 1570 If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200 DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J 39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected. IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J 39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and maximum (MAX) values measured. 1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of a suspected circuit to the other. 2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J 39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep). IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value in order to record the full change. 5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling the connections or the wiring, test driving, or performing other operations. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions. 6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9. Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist. Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections TESTING FOR INTERMITTENT CONDITIONS AND POOR CONNECTIONS TOOLS REQUIRED - J 35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit - J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit When the condition is not currently present, but is indicated in DTC history, the cause may be intermittent. An intermittent may also be the cause when there is a customer complaint, but the symptom cannot be duplicated. Refer to the Symptom Table of the system that is suspect of causing the condition before trying to locate an intermittent condition. Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the following items: Wiring broken inside the insulation - Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector - Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself, and corrosion in the wire to terminal contact area, etc. - Pierced or damaged insulation can allow moisture to enter the wiring causing corrosion. The conductor can corrode inside the insulation, with little visible evidence. Look for swollen and stiff sections of wire in the suspect circuits. - Wiring which has been pinched, cut, or its insulation rubbed through may cause an intermittent open or short as the bare area touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle. - Wiring that comes in contact with hot or exhaust components - Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required, in order to verify the customer concern. - Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. - Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis and Vehicle Data Recorder operation. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any inline connectors before replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation. Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination, usually in the underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit. Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper adapter. Always use the J 35616 when probing connectors. Other causes of terminal deformation are improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT IN BUSSED ELECTRICAL CENTERS (BEC) Page 4390 - In some cases Delphi will actually be printed on the connector. If Delphi is not printed on the connector, look for PED. In both cases there is no specific orientation for Delphi or PED and they can appear anywhere on the connector. - FCI connectors may have the FCI logo on their connectors. The logo is the letters FCI with an "A" above it. - JAE connector have JAE in small letters on their connectors. Page 8526 difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Bosch Connectors (ECM) BOSCH CONNECTORS (ECM) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the assist lever on the top of the connector. Move the assist lever to the forward position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 1969 Refer to the following table as a guide in selecting the correct test adapter for front probing connectors: Backprobe IMPORTANT: Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures. - Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector. - Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large of a test probe. - After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected, test for proper terminal contact. Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the connector. Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure SCAN TOOL SNAPSHOT PROCEDURE Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used Page 6569 4. Use a small flat-blade tool to slide the terminal position assurance (TPA) up one notch on both ends of the connector. The TPA is located underneath the wire dress cover. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 2806 Window Switch - RR Page 4248 8. Install a NEW crankshaft front oil seal. Refer to Crankshaft Front Oil Seal Replacement. 9. Install the water pump. Refer to Water Pump Replacement (LH6 and LS2). 10. Install the A/C compressor and bracket. Refer to Compressor Replacement (LH6, LS2) Compressor Replacement (LL8). Page 1720 11. Insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) into the 2 triangular cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 12. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE 1. Prior to installation the terminal must be aligned so the (1) coding lugs align with the (2) coding grooves on the connector. 2. Once the terminal is aligned, slide the terminal into the cavity until the retainer has engaged in the cavity of the connector. 3. Slide the TPA in the connector body and seat it using a small flat bladed tool. The TPA is seated when it is flush with the contact housing. 4. Secure the wires to the connector body using a tie wrap and replace the dress cover and grommet. Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) BOSCH CONNECTORS (2.8 JPT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Pull out the slider on the connector position assurance (CPA) until it is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 4781 Refer to the following table as a guide in selecting the correct test adapter for front probing connectors: Backprobe IMPORTANT: Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures. - Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector. - Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large of a test probe. - After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected, test for proper terminal contact. Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the connector. Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure SCAN TOOL SNAPSHOT PROCEDURE Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used Page 8449 2. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully push the terminal position assurance (TPA) towards the face of the connector on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA is fragile and may break if not done carefully. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. 3. Use the J 38125-215 tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. A/T - Key Will Not Release From Ignition Lock Cylinder Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Key Will Not Release From Ignition Lock Cylinder Bulletin No.: 05-07-30-021B Date: October 04, 2007 TECHNICAL Subject: Ignition Key Will Not Remove From Ignition Lock Cylinder (Reposition Shifter Boot) Models: 2004-2007 Buick Rainier 2002-2008 Chevrolet TrailBlazer Models 2002-2008 GMC Envoy Models 2003-2004 Oldsmobile Bravada Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to include the 2008 model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 05-07-30-021A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle). Condition Some customers may comment that they are unable to remove the ignition key from the ignition cylinder. Cause The shifter boot may be caught/trapped in the shifter assembly mechanism. Correction Inspect the shifter boot for being caught/trapped in the shifter assembly. If the shifter boot is NOT caught/trapped in the shift assembly, refer to Ignition Key Cannot Be Removed from the Ignition Lock Cylinder in SI. If the shifter boot IS caught/trapped in the shifter assembly, continue with the next step. DO NOT replace the complete shifter assembly for this condition. ONLY replace the shifter boot/handle if damaged by shifter assembly. Reposition the shifter boot so that it is not caught/trapped in the shifter assembly. Warranty Information Page 7811 7. The illustration above identifies the entry canal where the terminal release tool will be inserted, and the terminal cavity. - Terminal (1) - Entry Canal (2) 8. Insert the J-38125-553 (15315247) tool into the entry canal and pry up on the terminal retainer. The terminal retainer is a small plastic piece on the top of the terminal. The terminal retainer must be held up while the terminal is pulled out of the connector. Page 8554 Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. FCI Connectors FCI CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 5644 Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagrams Engine Controls Connector End Views Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor Page 6322 Connector Anatomy Connector Repairs contains a list of all connector repairs. The connector repairs are listed by the connector manufacturer and then by connector type. If the technician cannot identify the manufacturer of the connector, refer to Identifying Connectors below. Knowing the connector manufacturer will assist in finding the correct connector repair from the following list: - Connector Position Assurance Locks - Terminal Position Assurance Locks - Bosch Connectors (0.64) Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) Bosch Connectors (BSK) Bosch Connectors (ECM) - Delphi Connectors (Micro.64) Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) Delphi Connectors (12-Way) - Tyco/AMP Connectors (CM 42-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) Tyco/AMP Connectors (025 Cap) Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) - Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) - Repairing Connector Terminals IDENTIFYING CONNECTORS Knowing the connector manufacturer is helpful when trying to locating the correct connector repair procedure. There are many different connector designs used on GM vehicles and it is sometimes difficult to identify the connector manufacturer. The information in this document should help with the identification of connector manufactures. The following connector manufacturers make most of the connectors found in GM vehicles: AFL/EPC (Alcoa Fujikura Ltd./Engineered Plastics Components) - Bosch - Delphi - FCI (Framatome Connectors International) - JAE (Japan Aviation Electronics) - JST (Japan Solderless Terminals) Page 4548 6. Gently pry the plastic terminal retainer down and carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (16-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, pull the two connector halves apart. Page 2081 Page 4346 Disclaimer Page 8025 Release the lower wiredress cover locking tab. Release the upper wiredress cover locking tab. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. Locations Door Lock Relay: Locations Fuse Block - Rear, Label Page 302 Memory Seat Module - Driver C3 (w/Memory) Page 6439 View of a typical Micro 64 connector. Depress the lock and pull the lever over and past the lock. Page 5326 The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors. 1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position. 4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool J 38125-10A (GM P/N 12014012-1) into the front (mating end) of the connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal through the back of the connector (2). IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector. 6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. 7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily. 10. Perform system check. Delphi Connectors (12 Way) DELPHI CONNECTORS (12-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. Page 5198 2. Locate the two indents of the terminal position assurance (TPA) located on the bottom of the connector body. Page 7366 The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors. 1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position. 4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool J 38125-10A (GM P/N 12014012-1) into the front (mating end) of the connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal through the back of the connector (2). IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector. 6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. 7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily. 10. Perform system check. Delphi Connectors (12 Way) DELPHI CONNECTORS (12-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. Page 5437 - Yazaki has a wedge or arrow shape, similar to that shown. Delphi Connectors (Micro .64) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro 64 connectors. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. The lever lock may be located on the top or sides of the wire dress cover. Page 1209 Disclaimer Page 5431 5. Insert the J 38125-557 (GM P/N 12122378) into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 6. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Connector Position Assurance Locks CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of the connector. CPAs are used in various connectors throughout the vehicle. CPAs are also used in all SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals, of the connector. Connector Repairs CONNECTOR REPAIRS Page 7325 Page 5150 Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Page 5193 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the TPA. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the nose piece. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. Page 7404 Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size. REPAIRING A FUSIBLE LINK IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient overload protection. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. Flat Wire Repairs FLAT WIRE REPAIRS NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced. GMLAN Wiring Repairs GMLAN WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The GM Local Area Network (GMLAN) System requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working on GMLAN connectors and terminals. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items in order to repair the GMLAN wiring: Dura Seal splice sleeves - A wire stripping tool - J 38125-8 Crimping Tool (GM P/N 12085115) - J 38125-5 Ultra Torch Special Tool (GM P/N 12085116) The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. - A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors GMLAN REPAIRS IMPORTANT: When making a repair to any GMLAN network, the original wire length after the repair must be the same length as before the repair. If the network is a twisted pair, the twist must be maintained after the repair is completed. GMLAN has 2 types of networks, low speed and high speed. Low speed GMLAN has a single wire and works at slow speeds. High speed GMLAN has 2 wires in a twisted pair and works at higher speeds. For more information on GMLAN, refer to Data Link Communications Description and Operation. GMLAN CONNECTOR TERMINAL REPAIR IMPORTANT: A service terminal can be used to replace damaged connector terminals for both high speed and low speed GMLAN systems. When making a connector terminal repair on a GMLAN high speed system with twisted pair wires, do not untwist the wires more than necessary to make the repair. The terminals in the GMLAN system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are available in the J-38125. If the individual terminals are damaged on any GMLAN connection, use the appropriate connector repair procedure in order to repair the terminal. GMLAN WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 8749 Oxygen Sensor: Service Precautions Silicon Contamination of Heated Oxygen Sensors Notice Silicon Contamination of Heated Oxygen Sensors Notice Notice: Contamination of the oxygen sensor can result from the use of an inappropriate RTV sealant (not oxygen sensor safe) or excessive engine coolant or oil consumption. Remove the HO2S and visually inspect the portion of the sensor exposed to the exhaust stream in order to check for contamination. If contaminated, the portion of the sensor exposed to the exhaust stream will have a white powdery coating. Silicon contamination causes a high but false HO2S signal voltage (rich exhaust indication). The control module will then reduce the amount of fuel delivered to the engine, causing a severe driveability problem. Eliminate the source of contamination before replacing the oxygen sensor. Page 217 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) and slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. Page 1469 REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. The release tab is located on the top of the wiredress cover. View of connector in released position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Page 5732 5. While pushing the terminal forward, insert the J 38125-24 in the release cavity above the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (43-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Page 5614 5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape. Seat Belt Schematic Icons Seat Belt Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons Page 7239 6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias. Reference the appropriate service manual wiring schematic to obtain the correct diode installation position. 7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for the soldering equipment. 8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed. 9. IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode attachment points with tape. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape. Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable SPLICING TWISTED OR SHIELDED CABLE Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable. 1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splice is made. 3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire. Staggering the splices by 65 mm (2.5 in) is recommended. 4. IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical contact with the drain wire. Re-assemble the cable. Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape. - Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1). - Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire. - Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape. Page 2013 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully raise the TPA on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA cannot be removed from the connector while there are terminals present in the connector body. View of the TPA when removed from the connector body. 4. Use the J 38125-12A tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the left side of the terminal release cavity as shown in the graphic. Use the tool to move the terminal release to the right with a gentle prying motion. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 2116 View of a typical Micro 64 connector. Depress the lock and pull the lever over and past the lock. Page 5678 difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Bosch Connectors (ECM) BOSCH CONNECTORS (ECM) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the assist lever on the top of the connector. Move the assist lever to the forward position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 8437 3. Use a small flat-bladed tool to gently pry off the dress cover by inserting the tool under the cover opposite the harness side and prying up. 4. Remove the cover. 5. Using a small flat-bladed tool, push on the side of the nose piece retainer while pushing the nose piece forward with your thumb. This will release the terminal position assurance (TPA). 6. Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) into the corresponding terminal release cavity. The release cavities are the 2 center rows of cavities on one half of the connector. Page 6216 View of the connector when released from the component. View of another type of Micro 64 connector. Page 64 monitor the Tech2(R) for the current time and date. REMINDER - Keep in mind that the time displayed on the Tech2(R) is in Greenwich Mean Time (GMT) and the offset is based on the time zones relationship to GMT. If replacement of the VIU/VCIM is necessary, you MUST reconfigure the OnStar® system. Failure to reconfigure the system will result in an additional customer visit for repair. OnStar® VIU, Generations 2 and 3, will require the technician to press the blue OnStar® button to reconfigure the vehicle with an OnStar® advisor. OnStar(R) VCIM, Generations 4-7 will require the technician to reconfigure the vehicle with the use of the TIS2WEB and SPS applications (pass thru only), along with the Tech2(R). The configuration and set-up procedure is a two-step process that must be completed step-by-step without interruption or delay in between each step. This procedure enables an automated activation without a button press by the technician to the OnStar(R) Call Center. Following this procedure, it may take up to 24 hours for all OnStar(R) services to be fully activated. How to Order Parts If the OnStar(R) GPS date/time stamp is non-recoverable and the unit needs to be replaced, dealers in the U.S. should contact Autocraft Electronics select the catalog item that contains this bulletin number. Canadian dealers should contact MASS Electronics. Dealers DO NOT need to call the GM Technical Assistance Center (TAC) for replacement approval. Autocraft Electronics and MASS Electronics will be responsible for verifying that the subject vehicle is a candidate for a replacement VIU/VCIM. Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models) Page 5334 2. Locate the two indents of the terminal position assurance (TPA) located on the bottom of the connector body. Page 752 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert a small flat-blade tool in the slot below the front loaded terminal position assurance (TPA) and pry up. 3. Remove the TPA by pulling it out of the connector. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-553 (GM P/N 15315247) on a slight upward angle into the cavity below the terminal to be removed. Ensure that the pointed on the end of the tool is facing the bottom of the terminal and it stays in contact with the terminal until it stops on the plastic terminal retainer. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 6301 vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide variety of actions, including: - Wiggling the harness - Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting - Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector - Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation - Relocating a harness or wires All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. Another option is, with the component commanded ON and OFF by the scan tool, move related connectors and wiring and observe the component operation. With the engine running, move related connectors and wiring while monitoring engine operation. If harness or connector movement affects the data displayed, component/system operation, or engine operation, inspect and repair the harness/connections as necessary. You may need to load the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these cases you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide good results as well. There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions, along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the circuit to these kinds of conditions. SALT WATER SPRAY Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture. Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5 percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously. HIGH TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070. Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault condition. The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis. This option does not allow for the same control, however. LOW TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect. If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to -18°C (0°F) from one end and +71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized cooling needs. Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or components in an effort to duplicate the concern. DUPLICATING FAILURE CONDITIONS - If none of the previous tests are successful, attempt to duplicate and/or capture the failure conditions. Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, where applicable, contains the conditions that were present when the DTC set. 1. Review and record Freeze Frame/Failure Records data. 2. Clear the DTCs using the scan tool. 3. Turn the key to OFF and wait 15 seconds. 4. Operate the vehicle under the same conditions that were noted in Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, as closely as possible. The vehicle must also be operating within the Conditions for Running the DTC. Refer to Conditions for Running the DTC in the supporting text if a DTC is being diagnosed. 5. Monitor DTC Status for the DTC being tested. The scan tool will indicate Ran, when the enabling conditions have been satisfied long enough for the DTC to run. The scan tool will also indicate whether the DTC passed or failed. - An alternate method is to drive the vehicle with the DMM connected to a suspected circuit. An abnormal reading on the DMM when the concern occurs, may help you locate the concern. Measuring Frequency Page 560 Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay: Service and Repair Cooling Fan Relay Replacement Tools Required J 43244 Relay Puller Pliers Removal Procedure 1. Remove the underhood electrical center cover. 2. Using the J 43244, remove the cooling fan relay (3). Installation Procedure Notice: Installation of the proper relay is critical. If an enhanced relay - equipped with a diode - is installed into a position requiring a standard relay - equipped without a diode - excessive current will damage any components associated with the relay or its associated circuits. 1. Install the cooling fan relay (3). 2. Install the underhood electrical center cover. Page 8093 8. Install the ECM/TCM cover. 9. Ensure the ECM/TCM cover retainers (1) are fully engaged to the ECM/TCM bracket. 10. Connect the cooling fan electrical connector. 11. Connect the negative battery cable. 12. If the ECM was replaced the replacement ECM must be programmed. Refer to Control Module References. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Page 268 US English/Metric Conversion US English/Metric Conversion Page 1783 If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs SIR/SRS WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS, and the wiring components, such as connectors and terminals. IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system terminals. Use either an SIR/SRS pigtail or a terminated lead from the SIR Repair Kit Tray. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves, in order to repair the SIR/SRS wiring - A special crimping tool - A heat torch - An instruction manual The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides the necessary low resistance contact integrity for these sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors SIR/SRS CONNECTOR REPAIR (PLASTIC BODY AND TERMINAL METAL PIN) The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made with a special plating. This plating provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. Use the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit for repairing SIR/SRS terminals and connectors. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the repair kit. The J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit contains: Various terminated leads for sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) terminal replacement - Various connector positive assurance (CPA) locks for SIR/SRS connectors - Base of steering column pigtail connectors part number 12085514 - Yellow vinyl electrical tape Pigtail repair packs are available for SIR/SRS connectors with eight or less terminals. Only the connector body is available for connectors with more than eight terminals. The terminated leads in the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit can be used to replace damaged terminals when replacing the connector body. SIR/SRS COMPONENT WIRE PIGTAIL REPAIR IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails. A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device, not by a connector. If a wiring pigtail is damaged, you must replace the entire component, with pigtail. The inflatable restraint steering wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component. SIR/SRS WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 5809 Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. For connectors with a bolt in the dress cover, turn the bolt counterclockwise to remove the connector from the component. 2. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. Page 6410 Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Page 8640 Page 5723 7. The illustration above identifies the entry canal where the terminal release tool will be inserted, and the terminal cavity. - Terminal (1) - Entry Canal (2) 8. Insert the J-38125-553 (15315247) tool into the entry canal and pry up on the terminal retainer. The terminal retainer is a small plastic piece on the top of the terminal. The terminal retainer must be held up while the terminal is pulled out of the connector. Page 2399 11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the solder equipment. 12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. 13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to cover the first piece of tape. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE SLEEVES TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit IMPORTANT: Use only dura seal splice sleeves. Other splice sleeves may not protect the splice from moisture or provide a good electrical connection. Use duraseal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. Use duraseal splice sleeves where there is special requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire using duraseal splice sleeves. Page 5974 pulling it through. This will prevent damage to the internal seals of the connector. Once the terminal is pushed out of the connector, cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible and pull the wire through the connector. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE The Micro-Pack 100W connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool was developed to crimp Micro-Pack 100W terminals. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 2. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert the terminal into the crimp tool until the core wings are flush with the anvil on the crimp tool. Be sure that the wings are pointed toward the crimp tool former and release the spring locator. The locator will hold the terminal in place. Inspect the alignment of the terminal wings with the crimp tool former. If the terminal wings are wider than the crimp tool former, remove the terminal and bend the terminal wings in slightly. 5. Place stripped wire into terminal. 6. Crimp the new terminal to the wire. If a jam occurs, press the emergency release to open applicator. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire perform the following procedure in order to replace Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. Page 388 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert terminal into the appropriate terminal holder until it hits bottom and stops. The correct terminal holder is determined by the wire size. Also ensure that the terminals wings are pointing towards the former on the tool and the release locator. 5. Insert the stripped cable into the terminal. Insulation should be visible on both sides of the terminal insulation wings. 6. Compress the handles until the ratchet automatically releases. 7. Place the terminal into the appropriate cavity and assemble the connector. Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO-PACK 100W) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W connectors. These connectors are very similar but use different terminals and have some minor physical differences also. Page 6242 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry one side of the nose piece up to the pre-stage position. When the nose piece is in the pre-staged position, the nose piece will be raised above the connector body the length of the step in the nose piece. 7. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry the other side of the piece to the pre-stage position. If the nose piece is higher than the first step in the nose piece, gently push down on the nose piece until it meets with resistance from the connector body, you should feel the nose piece click into position. Page 6375 View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. 4. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers CIRCUIT PROTECTION - CIRCUIT BREAKERS A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types of circuit Page 9005 Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Page 6307 It is very important to use the correct test adapter when testing for proper terminal contact of fuses and relays in a bussed electrical center (BEC). Use J-35616-35 to test for proper terminal contact. Failure to use J-35616-35 can result in improper diagnosis of the BEC. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Separate the connector halves. 2. Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body. 3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J-38125 , test that the retention force is significantly different between a good terminal and a suspect terminal. Replace the female terminal in question. FLAT WIRE (DOCK AND LOCK) CONNECTORS There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock) connectors on the harness side or the component side. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Remove the component in question. 2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side of the connector as oil from your skin may be a source of contamination as well. 3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other imperfections that could cause poor terminal contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are uniform and free of damage or deformation. 4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the on the flat wire harness connector in order to test the circuit in question. CONTROL MODULE/COMPONENT VOLTAGE AND GROUNDS Poor voltage or ground connections can cause widely varying symptoms. Test all control module voltage supply circuits. Many vehicles have multiple circuits supplying voltage to a control module. Other components in the system may have separate voltage supply circuits that may also need to be tested. Inspect connections at the module/component connectors, fuses, and any intermediate connections between the voltage source and the module/component. A test lamp or a DMM may indicate that voltage is present, but neither tests the ability of the circuit to carry sufficient current. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Power Distribution Schematics. - Test all control module ground and system ground circuits. The control module may have multiple ground circuits. Other components in the system may have separate grounds that may also need to be tested. Inspect grounds for clean and tight connections at the grounding point. Inspect the connections at the component and in splice packs, where applicable. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Ground Distribution Schematics. TEMPERATURE SENSITIVITY - An intermittent condition may occur when a component/connection reaches normal operating temperature. The condition may occur only when the component/connection is cold, or only when the component/connection is hot. - Freeze Frame, Failure Records, Snapshot, or Vehicle Data Recorder data may help with this type of intermittent condition, where applicable. - If the intermittent is related to heat, review the data for a relationship with the following: High ambient temperatures - Underhood/engine generated heat - Circuit generated heat due to a poor connection, or high electrical load - Higher than normal load conditions, towing, etc. - If the intermittent is related to cold, review the data for the following: Low ambient temperatures-In extremely low temperatures, ice may form in a connection or component. Inspect for water intrusion. - The condition only occurs on a cold start. - The condition goes away when the vehicle warms up. - Information from the customer may help to determine if the trouble follows a pattern that is temperature related. - If temperature is suspected of causing an intermittent fault condition, attempt to duplicate the condition. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required. ELECTROMAGNETIC INTERFERENCE (EMI) AND ELECTRICAL NOISE Some electrical components/circuits are sensitive to electromagnetic interference (EMI) or other types of electrical noise. Inspect for the following conditions: A misrouted harness that is too close to high voltage/high current devices such as secondary ignition components, motors, generator etc-These components may induce electrical noise on a circuit that could interfere with normal circuit operation. - Electrical system interference caused by a malfunctioning relay, or a control module driven solenoid or switch-These conditions can cause a sharp electrical surge. Normally, the condition will occur when the malfunctioning component is operating. - Improper installation of non-factory or aftermarket add on accessories such as lights, 2-way radios, amplifiers, electric motors, remote starters, alarm systems, cell phones, etc-These accessories may lead to interference while in use, but do not fail when the accessories are not in use. - Test for an open diode across the A/C compressor clutch and for other open diodes. Some relays may contain a clamping diode. - The generator may be allowing AC noise into the electrical system. INCORRECT CONTROL MODULE - There are only a few situations where reprogramming a control module is appropriate: A new service control module is installed. Page 373 5. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove TPA from the connector. 6. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Page 4523 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully raise the TPA on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA cannot be removed from the connector while there are terminals present in the connector body. View of the TPA when removed from the connector body. 4. Use the J 38125-12A tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the left side of the terminal release cavity as shown in the graphic. Use the tool to move the terminal release to the right with a gentle prying motion. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 1427 MEASURING FREQUENCY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal. IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM to autorange to an appropriate range. 1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency measured. Measuring Voltage MEASURING VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit. 1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods: - Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. - Turn ON the engine. - Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls. - Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested. 3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The DMM displays the voltage measured at that point. Measuring Voltage Drop MEASURING VOLTAGE DROP NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points. Probing Electrical Connectors PROBING ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS Page 166 Page 6906 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert terminal into the appropriate terminal holder until it hits bottom and stops. The correct terminal holder is determined by the wire size. Also ensure that the terminals wings are pointing towards the former on the tool and the release locator. 5. Insert the stripped cable into the terminal. Insulation should be visible on both sides of the terminal insulation wings. 6. Compress the handles until the ratchet automatically releases. 7. Place the terminal into the appropriate cavity and assemble the connector. Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO-PACK 100W) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W connectors. These connectors are very similar but use different terminals and have some minor physical differences also. Page 4130 1. Install the oil filter bypass valve (2). Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Install the oil filter adapter (1). Tighten the adapter to 55 N.m (40 lb ft). 3. Install the oil filter. Tighten the filter to 30 N.m (22 lb ft). 4. Refill the engine oil if necessary. Refer to Approximate Fluid Capacities or to Fluid and Lubricant Recommendations. Page 1307 All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system. Page 8739 6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias. Reference the appropriate service manual wiring schematic to obtain the correct diode installation position. 7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for the soldering equipment. 8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed. 9. IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode attachment points with tape. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape. Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable SPLICING TWISTED OR SHIELDED CABLE Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable. 1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splice is made. 3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire. Staggering the splices by 65 mm (2.5 in) is recommended. 4. IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical contact with the drain wire. Re-assemble the cable. Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape. - Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1). - Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire. - Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape. Locations Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Locations Fuse Block - Underhood (5.3L/6.0L), Label Page 7224 2. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully push the terminal position assurance (TPA) towards the face of the connector on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA is fragile and may break if not done carefully. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. 3. Use the J 38125-215 tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Engine/Transmission - Aftermarket Calibrations Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine/Transmission - Aftermarket Calibrations INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 09-06-04-026B Date: April 07, 2010 Subject: Identifying Non-GM (Aftermarket) Engine and Transmission Calibrations for V8 Gas Engines Using Tech 2(R) or Global Diagnostic System (GDS) Models: 2006-2010 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Excluding Saab 9-7X) 2006-2009 HUMMER H2 2006-2010 HUMMER H3 Equipped with V8 Gas Powered Engines Only Attention: This bulletin applies to V8 gas powered engines ONLY. For Duramax(TM) diesel powered engines, refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 08-06-04-006G. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2010 model year and information about retrieving calibrations on a Global A vehicle. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 09-06-04-026A (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). General Motors is identifying an increasing number of engine, transmission and catalytic converter part failures that are the result of non-GM (aftermarket) engine and transmission control calibrations being used. When alteration to the GM-released engine or transmission control calibrations occurs, it subjects powertrain and driveline components (engine, transmission, transfer case, driveshaft and rear axle) to stresses that were not tested by General Motors. It is because of these unknown stresses, and the potential to alter reliability, durability and emissions performance, that GM has adopted a policy that prevents any UNAUTHORIZED dealer warranty claim submissions to any remaining warranty coverage, to the powertrain and driveline components whenever the presence of a non-GM (aftermarket) calibration is confirmed - even if the non-GM control module calibration is subsequently removed. Warranty coverage is based on the equipment and calibrations that were released on the vehicle at time of sale, or subsequently updated by GM. That's because GM testing and validation matches the calibration to a host of criteria that is essential to assure reliability, durability and emissions performance over the life of the warranty coverage and beyond. Stresses resulting from calibrations different from those tested and released by GM can damage or weaken components, leading to poor performance and or shortened life. Additionally, non-GM (aftermarket) issued engine control modifications often do not meet the same emissions performance standards as GM issued calibrations. Depending on state statutes, individuals who install engine control module calibrations that put the vehicle outside the parameters of emissions certification standards may be subject to fines and/or penalties. This bulletin outlines a procedure to identify the presence of non-GM (aftermarket) calibrations. GM recommends performing this check whenever a hard part failure is seen on internal engine or transmission components, or before an engine assembly or transmission assembly is being replaced under warranty. It is also recommended that the engine calibration verification procedure be performed whenever diagnostics indicate that catalytic converter replacement is indicated. The PQC has a process to confirm the ECM/PCM calibration is GM issued. The PQC will require a picture of the engine calibration verification screen, as outlined in this bulletin, before authorizing any V8 gas powered engine replacement. If a non-GM calibration is found and verification has taken place through GM, the remaining powertrain and driveline warranty will be blocked and notated in GMVIS and the dealership will be notified. This block prevents any UNAUTHORIZED warranty claim submission. 1. Connect the Tech 2(R) to the vehicle. 2. Go to: Diagnostics and build the vehicle. 3. Select: Powertrain. 4. Select: Engine. 5. *Select: Engine Control Module or PCM. 6. *Select: Module ID Information or I/M Information System if the Module ID Information selection is not available. 7. *If "I/M information System" was selected, it may be necessary to select "Vehicle Information" in order to display the calibration information. ‹› If the CVN information is displayed as "N/A", it will be necessary to contact the TCSC to obtain the CVN information. Page 1795 Page 7359 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert terminal into the appropriate terminal holder until it hits bottom and stops. The correct terminal holder is determined by the wire size. Also ensure that the terminals wings are pointing towards the former on the tool and the release locator. 5. Insert the stripped cable into the terminal. Insulation should be visible on both sides of the terminal insulation wings. 6. Compress the handles until the ratchet automatically releases. 7. Place the terminal into the appropriate cavity and assemble the connector. Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO-PACK 100W) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W connectors. These connectors are very similar but use different terminals and have some minor physical differences also. Page 3696 Vehicle Lifting: Service and Repair Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle Caution: To avoid any vehicle damage, serious personal injury or death when major components are removed from the vehicle and the vehicle is supported by a hoist, support the vehicle with jack stands at the opposite end from which the components are being removed and strap the vehicle to the hoist. Caution: To avoid any vehicle damage, serious personal injury or death, always use the jackstands to support the vehicle when lifting the vehicle with a jack. Notice: Perform the following steps before beginning any vehicle lifting or jacking procedure: * Remove or secure all of the vehicle's contents in order to avoid any shifting or any movement that may occur during the vehicle lifting or jacking procedure. * The lifting equipment or the jacking equipment weight rating must meet or exceed the weight of the vehicle and any vehicle contents. * The lifting equipment or the jacking equipment must meet the operational standards of the lifting equipment or jacking equipment's manufacturer. * Perform the vehicle lifting or jacking procedure on a clean, hard, dry, level surface. * Perform the vehicle lifting or jacking procedure only at the identified lift points. DO NOT allow the lifting equipment or jacking equipment to contact any other vehicle components. Failure to perform the previous steps could result in damage to the lifting equipment or the jacking equipment, the vehicle, and/or the vehicle's contents. Vehicle Lifting * Ensure that the lifting equipment meets weight requirements and is in good working order. Always follow the lift manufacturer's instructions. * You may lift and support the front of the vehicle at the front suspension near the wheel assemblies. Ensure that the arms of the front cradle are extended as close to the steering knuckle as possible. * Ensure that the vehicle is centered on the hoist before attempting to lift. * When using a suspension-contact hoist, ensure that the rear cradle has adequate clearance for the rear stabilizer bar. Page 1268 Horn Switch: Locations Steering Wheel And Column Page 3725 Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested: - Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. - Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a component or to other harnesses. - If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A TEST LAMP TOOLS REQUIRED J 35616-200 Test Light - Probe Kit NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminate even though voltage is present. The J 35616-200 is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair of leads. To properly operate this tool use the following procedures. When testing for voltage: 1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested. When testing for ground: 1. Attach one lead to battery positive voltage. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where ground should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is ground at the point being tested. Using Connector Test Adapters USING CONNECTOR TEST ADAPTERS NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Using Fused Jumper Wires USING FUSED JUMPER WIRES TOOLS REQUIRED J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged. The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested. AFL/ECP Connectors AFL/EPC CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 8897 If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200 DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J 39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected. IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J 39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and maximum (MAX) values measured. 1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of a suspected circuit to the other. 2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J 39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep). IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value in order to record the full change. 5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling the connections or the wiring, test driving, or performing other operations. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions. 6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9. Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist. Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections TESTING FOR INTERMITTENT CONDITIONS AND POOR CONNECTIONS TOOLS REQUIRED - J 35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit - J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit When the condition is not currently present, but is indicated in DTC history, the cause may be intermittent. An intermittent may also be the cause when there is a customer complaint, but the symptom cannot be duplicated. Refer to the Symptom Table of the system that is suspect of causing the condition before trying to locate an intermittent condition. Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the following items: Wiring broken inside the insulation - Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector - Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself, and corrosion in the wire to terminal contact area, etc. - Pierced or damaged insulation can allow moisture to enter the wiring causing corrosion. The conductor can corrode inside the insulation, with little visible evidence. Look for swollen and stiff sections of wire in the suspect circuits. - Wiring which has been pinched, cut, or its insulation rubbed through may cause an intermittent open or short as the bare area touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle. - Wiring that comes in contact with hot or exhaust components - Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required, in order to verify the customer concern. - Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. - Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis and Vehicle Data Recorder operation. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any inline connectors before replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation. Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination, usually in the underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit. Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper adapter. Always use the J 35616 when probing connectors. Other causes of terminal deformation are improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT IN BUSSED ELECTRICAL CENTERS (BEC) Page 7096 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the DuraSeal splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of a connector. CPAs are used in all SIR System connectors and also in some connectors of other systems. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals of a connection. TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE CLIPS IMPORTANT: When making a splice in an area that may be exposed to moisture use a crimp and seal splice sleeve instead of a Splice Clip. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. Page 5122 results from the alteration or modification of a vehicle using non-GM approved parts or accessories. Dealers should be especially cautious of accessory companies that claim the installation of their product will not void the factory warranty. Many times these companies have even given direction on how to quickly disassemble the accessory in an attempt to preclude the manufacturer from finding out that is has been installed. Any suspect repairs should be reviewed by the Fixed Operations Manager (FOM), and in Canada by the Warranty Manager (WM) for appropriate repair direction. If it is decided that a goodwill repair is to be made on the vehicle, even with the installation of such non-GM approved components, the customer is to be made aware of General Motors position on this issue and is to sign the appropriate goodwill documentation required by General Motors. It is imperative for dealers to understand that by installing such devices, they are jeopardizing not only the warranty coverage, but also the performance and reliability of the customer's vehicle. Disclaimer Page 1432 It is very important to use the correct test adapter when testing for proper terminal contact of fuses and relays in a bussed electrical center (BEC). Use J-35616-35 to test for proper terminal contact. Failure to use J-35616-35 can result in improper diagnosis of the BEC. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Separate the connector halves. 2. Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body. 3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J-38125 , test that the retention force is significantly different between a good terminal and a suspect terminal. Replace the female terminal in question. FLAT WIRE (DOCK AND LOCK) CONNECTORS There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock) connectors on the harness side or the component side. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Remove the component in question. 2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side of the connector as oil from your skin may be a source of contamination as well. 3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other imperfections that could cause poor terminal contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are uniform and free of damage or deformation. 4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the on the flat wire harness connector in order to test the circuit in question. CONTROL MODULE/COMPONENT VOLTAGE AND GROUNDS Poor voltage or ground connections can cause widely varying symptoms. Test all control module voltage supply circuits. Many vehicles have multiple circuits supplying voltage to a control module. Other components in the system may have separate voltage supply circuits that may also need to be tested. Inspect connections at the module/component connectors, fuses, and any intermediate connections between the voltage source and the module/component. A test lamp or a DMM may indicate that voltage is present, but neither tests the ability of the circuit to carry sufficient current. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Power Distribution Schematics. - Test all control module ground and system ground circuits. The control module may have multiple ground circuits. Other components in the system may have separate grounds that may also need to be tested. Inspect grounds for clean and tight connections at the grounding point. Inspect the connections at the component and in splice packs, where applicable. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Ground Distribution Schematics. TEMPERATURE SENSITIVITY - An intermittent condition may occur when a component/connection reaches normal operating temperature. The condition may occur only when the component/connection is cold, or only when the component/connection is hot. - Freeze Frame, Failure Records, Snapshot, or Vehicle Data Recorder data may help with this type of intermittent condition, where applicable. - If the intermittent is related to heat, review the data for a relationship with the following: High ambient temperatures - Underhood/engine generated heat - Circuit generated heat due to a poor connection, or high electrical load - Higher than normal load conditions, towing, etc. - If the intermittent is related to cold, review the data for the following: Low ambient temperatures-In extremely low temperatures, ice may form in a connection or component. Inspect for water intrusion. - The condition only occurs on a cold start. - The condition goes away when the vehicle warms up. - Information from the customer may help to determine if the trouble follows a pattern that is temperature related. - If temperature is suspected of causing an intermittent fault condition, attempt to duplicate the condition. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required. ELECTROMAGNETIC INTERFERENCE (EMI) AND ELECTRICAL NOISE Some electrical components/circuits are sensitive to electromagnetic interference (EMI) or other types of electrical noise. Inspect for the following conditions: A misrouted harness that is too close to high voltage/high current devices such as secondary ignition components, motors, generator etc-These components may induce electrical noise on a circuit that could interfere with normal circuit operation. - Electrical system interference caused by a malfunctioning relay, or a control module driven solenoid or switch-These conditions can cause a sharp electrical surge. Normally, the condition will occur when the malfunctioning component is operating. - Improper installation of non-factory or aftermarket add on accessories such as lights, 2-way radios, amplifiers, electric motors, remote starters, alarm systems, cell phones, etc-These accessories may lead to interference while in use, but do not fail when the accessories are not in use. - Test for an open diode across the A/C compressor clutch and for other open diodes. Some relays may contain a clamping diode. - The generator may be allowing AC noise into the electrical system. INCORRECT CONTROL MODULE - There are only a few situations where reprogramming a control module is appropriate: A new service control module is installed. Page 6659 MEASURING FREQUENCY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal. IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM to autorange to an appropriate range. 1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency measured. Measuring Voltage MEASURING VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit. 1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods: - Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. - Turn ON the engine. - Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls. - Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested. 3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The DMM displays the voltage measured at that point. Measuring Voltage Drop MEASURING VOLTAGE DROP NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points. Probing Electrical Connectors PROBING ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS Page 4791 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (BSK) BOSCH CONNECTORS (BSK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 3. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 4. Insert the J 38125-561 tool into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 5. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is Page 3917 20. Extract a portion of the ECT sensor harness wiring and connector from the protective conduit. Cut off the ECT sensor harness connector and wiring. 21. Determine a routing path for the ECT sensor jumper harness wires so that they can be secured TO or WITHIN an existing protective conduit. Note This step is to set up and verify the length of wiring that is required before cutting. 22. Route the ECT sensor jumper wires and then enclose them in their own protective conduit in order to VERIFY the length that is required. 23. Cut the ECT sensor jumper wires to the appropriate length. Note Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splice or connector. 24. Splice the ECT sensor jumper wires to the ORIGINAL ECT HARNESS LOCATION using DuraSeal weatherproof splices. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves in SI. Note Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splice or connector. 25. Splice the ECT sensor jumper wires to the ECT SENSOR HARNESS CONNECTOR using DuraSeal weatherproof splices. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves in SI. 26. Connect the ECT sensor harness connector to the ECT sensor. 27. Secure the ECT sensor jumper wires that are in their own protective conduit TO or WITHIN the existing harness conduit using tie straps. Important You MUST run the engine at the specified RPM and until it reaches normal operating temperature and then allow it to idle as indicated in SI. The engine MUST then be allowed to cool down in order to top off the coolant level as needed. 28. Fill the cooling system to the proper level. Refer to Cooling System Draining and Filling in SI. 29. Pressure test the cooling system. Refer to Cooling System Leak Testing in SI. 30. Use a scan tool to clear any DTCs. Relocating the Engine Coolant Heater Cord Important For reference, the procedure and graphics that are shown are from a Chevrolet Silverado, but are similar for the other vehicles listed above. 1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Ask the customer where they would prefer the extension cord to exit from the engine compartment in order to determine the required extension cord length. 3. Obtain an extension cord with the following features: - 120 volt - 14/3 gauge - 15A capacity - Three prong - Polarized plug and receptacle - Chemical resistant - Grounded terminals - Designed for use in a cold outdoor environment - Outer jacket resistant to deterioration from moisture, abrasion and exposure to sunlight - Maximum length of 2.5-3 m (8-10 ft) 4. Release enough of the clips that retain the engine coolant heater cord to the vehicle to provide the necessary length for repositioning. 5. Apply dielectric grease to the electrical contacts of the heater cord receptacle and the extension cord plug to prevent corrosion. Use GM P/N 12345579 (in Canada, use P/N 10953481) or an equivalent. 6. Connect the heater cord receptacle to the extension cord plug and wipe OFF any excess grease. Page 2238 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Ensure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the Terminal Removal Procedure. Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PULL TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL If the terminal is visibly damaged or is suspected of having a faulty connection, the terminal should be replaced. Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors: 1. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) device and/or the secondary lock. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component or separate the connectors for in-line connectors. 3. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device. 4. Insert the proper pick or removal tool into the front of the connector body. 5. IMPORTANT: On connectors with more than one terminal the service loop may not be large enough to remove the terminal and crimp on a new one. If the terminal wire does not have a large enough service loop for removal, cut the wire 5 cm (2 in) behind the connector before removal. Grasp the wire at the back of the connector body and gently push the terminal out the front of the connector body. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. If the wire needed to be cut in order to remove the terminal, gently push a small length of the same size wire through the back of the connector cavity until there is enough wire exposed in order to crimp on a new terminal. If the wire was not cut, cut the existing wire as close to the old terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 4. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. TERMINAL INSTALLATION 1. Align the terminal and pull the wire from the back of the connector in order to seat the terminal. 2. If necessary, cut the new wire to proper length and splice with existing circuit. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. 3. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply dielectric grease to the connector. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PUSH TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 8925 2. Locate the nose piece locking tabs that are positioned on the side of the connector nose piece. The connector nose piece acts as a terminal positive assurance (TPA) and may be referred to as such. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to push in one of the locking tabs while gently pulling on the same side of the nose piece. 4. Repeat the procedure for the other locking tab and remove the nose piece. 5. Remove the wire dress cover. The following is a general procedure for wire dress cover removal. Use this procedure as a guide, some dress cover removal procedures may vary. 6. Use fingers to squeeze the 2 locking legs of the cover. Page 5726 7. Pressing the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool in the release cavity of the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and crimper in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (DOOR MODULE) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Side view of connector. View of top of connector. 1. Locate the assist lever and lock on the top of the connector. Page 7418 US English/Metric Conversion US English/Metric Conversion Page 5265 normal, replace the ECM. 6. Connect a test lamp between the relay coil B+ and the relay coil control circuit. 7. Ignition ON, command the powertrain relay ON and OFF with a scan tool. The test lamp should turn ON and OFF when changing between the commanded states. ‹› If the test lamp is always ON, test the relay coil control circuit for a short to ground. If the circuit tests normal, replace the ECM. ‹› If the test lamp is always OFF, test the relay coil control circuit for a short to voltage or an open/high resistance. If the circuit tests normal, replace the ECM. 8. Connect a 20A fused jumper wire between the relay switch B+ and the relay ignition 1 voltage circuit. 9. Ignition ON, engine OFF, monitor the EC Ignition Relay Feedback parameter with a scan tool. The parameter should display B+. ‹› If the parameter does not display B+, test the ignition 1 voltage circuit for an open/high resistance. If the circuit tests normal, replace the ECM. 10. If all circuits test normal, test or replace the relay. Component Testing 1. Ignition OFF, disconnect the powertrain relay. 2. Test for 65-110 ohms of resistance between terminals 85 and 86 of the relay. ‹› If the resistance is not within the specified range, replace the relay. 3. Test for infinite resistance between following terminals: * Terminal 30 and 86 * Terminal 30 and 87 * Terminal 30 and 85 * Terminal 85 and 87 ‹› If not the specified value, replace the relay. 4. Install a 20A fused jumper wire between relay terminal 85 and 12 volts. Install a jumper wire between relay terminal 86 and ground. Test for less than 1 ohm of resistance between terminals 30 and 87. ‹› If greater than the specified range, replace the relay. Repair Instructions Perform the Diagnostic Repair Verification after completing the diagnostic procedure. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests and Procedures * Relay Replacement (Attached to Wire Harness) Relay Replacement (Within an Electrical Center) * Underhood Electrical Center or Junction Block Replacement * Control Module References for ECM replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Page 6838 Ignition Cable: Service and Repair Spark Plug Wire Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Remove the spark plug wire from the spark plug. * Twist each spark plug 1/2 turn. * Pull only on the boot in order to remove the wire from each spark plug. 2. Remove the spark plug wire from the ignition coil. * Twist each spark plug boot 1/2 turn. * Pull only on the boot in order to remove the wires from the ignition coil. Installation Procedure 1. Install the spark plug wire to the ignition coil. 2. Install the spark plug wire to the spark plug. 3. Inspect the wires for proper installation: * Push sideways on each boot in order to inspect the seating. * Reinstall any loose boot. Page 1754 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. 4. Remove the dress cover by using a flat bladed tool to release the dress cover locking tabs and lift up on the dress cover. 5. Cut the tie wrap that holds the wires to the connector body. Page 7489 5. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove TPA from the connector. 6. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Page 6219 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert terminal into the appropriate terminal holder until it hits bottom and stops. The correct terminal holder is determined by the wire size. Also ensure that the terminals wings are pointing towards the former on the tool and the release locator. 5. Insert the stripped cable into the terminal. Insulation should be visible on both sides of the terminal insulation wings. 6. Compress the handles until the ratchet automatically releases. 7. Place the terminal into the appropriate cavity and assemble the connector. Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO-PACK 100W) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W connectors. These connectors are very similar but use different terminals and have some minor physical differences also. Page 1094 Parking Brake Warning Switch: Diagrams Hydraulic Brake Connector End Views Park Brake Switch Page 1415 Page 260 If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs SIR/SRS WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS, and the wiring components, such as connectors and terminals. IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system terminals. Use either an SIR/SRS pigtail or a terminated lead from the SIR Repair Kit Tray. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves, in order to repair the SIR/SRS wiring - A special crimping tool - A heat torch - An instruction manual The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides the necessary low resistance contact integrity for these sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors SIR/SRS CONNECTOR REPAIR (PLASTIC BODY AND TERMINAL METAL PIN) The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made with a special plating. This plating provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. Use the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit for repairing SIR/SRS terminals and connectors. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the repair kit. The J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit contains: Various terminated leads for sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) terminal replacement - Various connector positive assurance (CPA) locks for SIR/SRS connectors - Base of steering column pigtail connectors part number 12085514 - Yellow vinyl electrical tape Pigtail repair packs are available for SIR/SRS connectors with eight or less terminals. Only the connector body is available for connectors with more than eight terminals. The terminated leads in the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit can be used to replace damaged terminals when replacing the connector body. SIR/SRS COMPONENT WIRE PIGTAIL REPAIR IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails. A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device, not by a connector. If a wiring pigtail is damaged, you must replace the entire component, with pigtail. The inflatable restraint steering wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component. SIR/SRS WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Engine - Low Oil Lamp ON/Oil Leaks Oil Pressure Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Low Oil Lamp ON/Oil Leaks TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 07-06-01-004A Date: November 25, 2008 Subject: All Vortec(R) GEN IV V8 Engines - LY2 LS4 LC9 LH6 LMG LY5 LS2 L76 LY6 L92 LS7, Low Oil Level Indicator Lamp On and/or Engine Oil Leak (Reseal Oil Pressure Sensor) Models Supercede: This bulletin is being updated to include a labor operation number for CTS-V and Corvette models. Please discard Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 07-06-01-004 (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System). Condition Some customers may comment on a low oil level indicator lamp on and/or engine oil leak. Upon further investigation, the technician may find that the oil leak is at the oil pressure sensor that is threaded into the valve lifter oil manifold (VLOM) assembly and/or engine valley cover. Correction If the engine oil leak was found to be at the engine oil pressure sensor, then remove the oil pressure sensor and reseal with a pipe sealant with Teflon or equivalent, P/N 12346004 (in Canada, P/N 10953480). Refer to Engine Oil Pressure Sensor and/or Switch Replacement in SI. Parts Information Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models) Page 877 9. The illustration shows a cutaway view of the connector to aid the technician in releasing the terminal retainer. 10. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Terminal Position Assurance Locks TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Tyco/Amp Connectors (CM 42-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (CM 42-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the connector body and pull the CPA out. The CPA is on the wire harness side of connector. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 1364 MOLEX CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. 2. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. Page 1389 If a wire is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm, etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except coaxial. - Do not use the DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent American wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 7615 3. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. View showing depressing of the lever lock release tab. Diagram Information and Instructions Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions Electrical Symbols Page 1062 Seat Adjuster Switch - Driver (AR9) Seat Adjuster Switch - Passenger (With RPO Code V40) Page 8186 2. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 4587 MEASURING FREQUENCY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal. IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM to autorange to an appropriate range. 1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency measured. Measuring Voltage MEASURING VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit. 1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods: - Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. - Turn ON the engine. - Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls. - Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested. 3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The DMM displays the voltage measured at that point. Measuring Voltage Drop MEASURING VOLTAGE DROP NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points. Probing Electrical Connectors PROBING ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS Page 1211 Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair Fuel Sender Assembly Replacement Tools Required J45722 Fuel Tank Sending Unit Wrench Removal Procedure 1. Remove the fuel tank. 2. Remove the fuel feed (1) and EVAP (2) lines from the fuel sender assembly. Notice: Avoid damaging the lock ring. Use only J-45722 to prevent damage to the lock ring. Notice: Do Not handle the fuel sender assembly by the fuel pipes. The amount of leverage generated by handling the fuel pipes could damage the joints. Important: Do NOT use impact tools. Significant force will be required to release the lock ring. The use of a hammer and screwdriver is not recommended. Secure the fuel tank in order to prevent fuel tank rotation. 3. Use the J45722 and a long breaker-bar in order to unlock the fuel sender lock ring. Turn the fuel sender lock ring in a counterclockwise direction. Page 6319 6. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs located on the opposite side of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover at the connector end and pry up. 7. Remove the dress cover. 8. Cut the tie wrap on the wire bundle. 9. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting a small flat-bladed tool into the small slot in the end of the slider and pushing on the TPA until it comes out of the connector. When the TPA exits the opposite side of the connector, gasp the TPA and pull it completely out of the connector. 10. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Locations Crankshaft Position Sensor: Locations Engine Controls Component Views Lower Right Side of the Engine - Rear 1 - Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor 2 - Knock Sensor (KS) 2 - Right 3 - Engine Harness 4 Starter 5 - Engine Page 5706 Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. FCI Connectors FCI CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 8817 Release the lower wiredress cover locking tab. Release the upper wiredress cover locking tab. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. Page 8573 3. Use a small flat-bladed tool to gently pry off the dress cover by inserting the tool under the cover opposite the harness side and prying up. 4. Remove the cover. 5. Using a small flat-bladed tool, push on the side of the nose piece retainer while pushing the nose piece forward with your thumb. This will release the terminal position assurance (TPA). 6. Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) into the corresponding terminal release cavity. The release cavities are the 2 center rows of cavities on one half of the connector. Page 8167 4. Use a small flat-blade tool to slide the terminal position assurance (TPA) up one notch on both ends of the connector. The TPA is located underneath the wire dress cover. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 5837 TERMINAL REMOVAL Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors. 1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA) device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1). 3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 4. Gently pull the cable and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector. 5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal, refer to Terminal Repair. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3. Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector. REINSTALLING TERMINAL 1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly, refer to Wiring Repairs. 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3. Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) DELPHI CONNECTORS (WEATHER PACK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 5781 7. Connect the MAF/IAT electrical connector. Page 5577 MOLEX CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. 2. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. Page 5817 IMPORTANT: Ensure that the dress cover and connector body are both in the released position before reassembling. Failure to do so may cause damage to the connector and component. Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (0.64) BOSCH CONNECTORS (0.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While pressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock until the lever is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Pull the rubber boot that covers the wires back to expose the end of the connector dress cover. 4. Place the connector locking lever in the center of the connector. 5. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs that are on the wire end of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover and connector body and pry up. Page 193 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. 4. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front of the connector. Page 3772 8. Insert the J 38125-213 into the small terminal release hole on the nose piece and gently pull on the back of the wire. 9. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Repairing Connector Terminals REPAIRING CONNECTOR TERMINALS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following: Push to Seat terminals - Pull to Seat terminals Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your terminal repair. The J-38125 contains further information. 1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.For cable seal terminals, remove the seal. 2. Apply the correct cable seal per gage size of the wire, if used.Slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation removal. 3. Remove the insulation. 4. For sealed terminals only, align the seal with the end of the cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal.For sealed terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal. 6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.For sealed terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable. 8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals excepting Micro-Pack 100.64 size. Soldering Micro-Pack 100 World terminals may damage the terminal. Sumitomo Connectors SUMITOMO CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 6550 - Most Molex connectors will have the Molex logo on the dresscover of the connector. In some cases the connectors may have MX followed by another letter. The third letter indicates where the connector was made. A connector with MXD is a Molex connector made in Detroit. Sumitomo has a unique symbol on their connector and possibly a part number. The symbol is similar to that of a diamond lying on its side, similar to that shown. The logo could appear anywhere but the most common place is at the wire side of the housing. Tyco/AMP has many different and unique connector designs. Some may or may not have identifiable marks on them. Page 4604 6. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs located on the opposite side of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover at the connector end and pry up. 7. Remove the dress cover. 8. Cut the tie wrap on the wire bundle. 9. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting a small flat-bladed tool into the small slot in the end of the slider and pushing on the TPA until it comes out of the connector. When the TPA exits the opposite side of the connector, gasp the TPA and pull it completely out of the connector. 10. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 1519 Camshaft Position Sensor: Connector Views Engine Controls Connector End Views Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor Page 416 7. The illustration above identifies the entry canal where the terminal release tool will be inserted, and the terminal cavity. - Terminal (1) - Entry Canal (2) 8. Insert the J-38125-553 (15315247) tool into the entry canal and pry up on the terminal retainer. The terminal retainer is a small plastic piece on the top of the terminal. The terminal retainer must be held up while the terminal is pulled out of the connector. Page 197 11. Insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) into the 2 triangular cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 12. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE 1. Prior to installation the terminal must be aligned so the (1) coding lugs align with the (2) coding grooves on the connector. 2. Once the terminal is aligned, slide the terminal into the cavity until the retainer has engaged in the cavity of the connector. 3. Slide the TPA in the connector body and seat it using a small flat bladed tool. The TPA is seated when it is flush with the contact housing. 4. Secure the wires to the connector body using a tie wrap and replace the dress cover and grommet. Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) BOSCH CONNECTORS (2.8 JPT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Pull out the slider on the connector position assurance (CPA) until it is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 8277 Release the lower wiredress cover locking tab. Release the upper wiredress cover locking tab. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. Engine Controls - MIL ON/Misfire/Misfire DTC's Set Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Engine Controls - MIL ON/Misfire/Misfire DTC's Set Bulletin No.: 06-06-04-046 Date: September 12, 2006 INFORMATION Subject: Information on Engine Misfire MIL/SES Light Illuminated or Flashing DTC P0300, P0301, P0302, P0303, P0304, P0305, P0306, P0307, P0308, P0420 or P0430 Models: 1999-2007 Cadillac, Chevrolet, GMC Full-Size Pickup and/or Utility Trucks with 4.8L, 5.3L, 5.7L, 6.0L or 6.2L VORTEC GEN III, GEN IV, V-8 Engine (VINs V, C, T, Z, B, 3, M, 0, J, R, U, N, Y, K, 8 - RPOs LR4, LY2, LM7, L59, L33, LC9, LH6, LMG, LY5, L31, LQ4, LQ9, L76, LY6, L92) with Active Fuel Management(TM) and E85 Flex Fuel If you encounter vehicles that exhibit the above conditions, refer to SI for the appropriate DTC(s) set. If no trouble is found, the cause may be due to an ECM ground terminal that has corroded with rust over time. Inspect the main engine wiring harness ground terminal (G103) for this condition. The wire terminal (G103) attaches either to the front or to the rear of the right side cylinder head, depending on the model year of the Full Size Pickup and/or Utility Trucks. If the ECM ground terminal has been found to be corroded, then follow the service procedure outlined in this bulletin to correct the corrosion issue. Remove either the nut or bolt securing the main engine wiring harness ground terminal (G103) to the right cylinder head. Refer to the above illustration to determine where the ground is located on the vehicle (1). Page 4646 9. The illustration shows a cutaway view of the connector to aid the technician in releasing the terminal retainer. 10. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Terminal Position Assurance Locks TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Tyco/Amp Connectors (CM 42-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (CM 42-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the connector body and pull the CPA out. The CPA is on the wire harness side of connector. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 2241 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) and slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. Page 8430 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry one side of the nose piece up to the pre-stage position. When the nose piece is in the pre-staged position, the nose piece will be raised above the connector body the length of the step in the nose piece. 7. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry the other side of the piece to the pre-stage position. If the nose piece is higher than the first step in the nose piece, gently push down on the nose piece until it meets with resistance from the connector body, you should feel the nose piece click into position. Page 7382 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry one side of the nose piece up to the pre-stage position. When the nose piece is in the pre-staged position, the nose piece will be raised above the connector body the length of the step in the nose piece. 7. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry the other side of the piece to the pre-stage position. If the nose piece is higher than the first step in the nose piece, gently push down on the nose piece until it meets with resistance from the connector body, you should feel the nose piece click into position. Diagrams Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Diagrams Engine Controls Connector End Views Mass Air Flow (MAF)/Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor Diagram Information and Instructions Throttle Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions Electrical Symbols Page 2328 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. 4. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front of the connector. Locations Oxygen Sensor: Locations Engine Controls Component Views Below Rear of the Engine 1 - Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Bank 2 Sensor 2 2 - Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Bank 2 Sensor 1 3 - Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Bank 1 Sensor 2 4 - Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Bank 1 Sensor 1 Page 1938 Oxygen Sensor: Service Precautions Silicon Contamination of Heated Oxygen Sensors Notice Silicon Contamination of Heated Oxygen Sensors Notice Notice: Contamination of the oxygen sensor can result from the use of an inappropriate RTV sealant (not oxygen sensor safe) or excessive engine coolant or oil consumption. Remove the HO2S and visually inspect the portion of the sensor exposed to the exhaust stream in order to check for contamination. If contaminated, the portion of the sensor exposed to the exhaust stream will have a white powdery coating. Silicon contamination causes a high but false HO2S signal voltage (rich exhaust indication). The control module will then reduce the amount of fuel delivered to the engine, causing a severe driveability problem. Eliminate the source of contamination before replacing the oxygen sensor. Page 6101 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Ensure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the Terminal Removal Procedure. Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PULL TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL If the terminal is visibly damaged or is suspected of having a faulty connection, the terminal should be replaced. Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors: 1. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) device and/or the secondary lock. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component or separate the connectors for in-line connectors. 3. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device. 4. Insert the proper pick or removal tool into the front of the connector body. 5. IMPORTANT: On connectors with more than one terminal the service loop may not be large enough to remove the terminal and crimp on a new one. If the terminal wire does not have a large enough service loop for removal, cut the wire 5 cm (2 in) behind the connector before removal. Grasp the wire at the back of the connector body and gently push the terminal out the front of the connector body. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. If the wire needed to be cut in order to remove the terminal, gently push a small length of the same size wire through the back of the connector cavity until there is enough wire exposed in order to crimp on a new terminal. If the wire was not cut, cut the existing wire as close to the old terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 4. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. TERMINAL INSTALLATION 1. Align the terminal and pull the wire from the back of the connector in order to seat the terminal. 2. If necessary, cut the new wire to proper length and splice with existing circuit. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. 3. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply dielectric grease to the connector. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PUSH TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 4722 6. Heater outlet hose to engine (6). 7. Heater inlet hose to front of dash (7). 8. Heater outlet hose to front of dash (8). Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models) Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models) Page 1486 9. The illustration shows a cutaway view of the connector to aid the technician in releasing the terminal retainer. 10. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Terminal Position Assurance Locks TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Tyco/Amp Connectors (CM 42-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (CM 42-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the connector body and pull the CPA out. The CPA is on the wire harness side of connector. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 5653 Page 240 7. Pressing the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool in the release cavity of the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and crimper in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (DOOR MODULE) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Side view of connector. View of top of connector. 1. Locate the assist lever and lock on the top of the connector. Page 4497 Connector Anatomy Connector Repairs contains a list of all connector repairs. The connector repairs are listed by the connector manufacturer and then by connector type. If the technician cannot identify the manufacturer of the connector, refer to Identifying Connectors below. Knowing the connector manufacturer will assist in finding the correct connector repair from the following list: - Connector Position Assurance Locks - Terminal Position Assurance Locks - Bosch Connectors (0.64) Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) Bosch Connectors (BSK) Bosch Connectors (ECM) - Delphi Connectors (Micro.64) Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) Delphi Connectors (12-Way) - Tyco/AMP Connectors (CM 42-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) Tyco/AMP Connectors (025 Cap) Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) - Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) - Repairing Connector Terminals IDENTIFYING CONNECTORS Knowing the connector manufacturer is helpful when trying to locating the correct connector repair procedure. There are many different connector designs used on GM vehicles and it is sometimes difficult to identify the connector manufacturer. The information in this document should help with the identification of connector manufactures. The following connector manufacturers make most of the connectors found in GM vehicles: AFL/EPC (Alcoa Fujikura Ltd./Engineered Plastics Components) - Bosch - Delphi - FCI (Framatome Connectors International) - JAE (Japan Aviation Electronics) - JST (Japan Solderless Terminals) Page 2281 The engine harness may be repaired using the J-38125. High Temperature Wiring Repairs HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperatures, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time may use materials i.e. wires, connectors, and shielding that has a higher heat rating than typical wiring. When making a repair in a high temperature area observe the following: Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature to replace any damaged wire. - Replace any heat shielding that is removed. - Cover any DuraSeal splice sleeves with SCT1 shrink tubing (available in the J-38125 Terminal Repair kit). - After making a wiring repair, ensure that the location of the wiring is not moved closer to the heat source. IDENTIFYING HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperature, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time need special considerations when making wiring repairs. Areas that may be exposed to higher temperatures can be identified by heat resistant materials that are being used in those areas. These materials may include heat reflective tape, moon tape, and high temperature shrink tubing. Also conduit and other protective coverings may be used. Because conduit or similar coverings are used throughout the vehicle regardless of the temperature, it may be necessary for the technician to determine if an area is exposed to excessive heat before making a wiring repair. Obvious areas of consideration would be any area located near the exhaust manifolds, catalytic converter, and exhaust pipes. The J-38125 contains much of the material you will need to perform repairs on areas exposed to high heat. The kit contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves to crimp and seal connections - High temperature SCT1 shrink tubing to protect the splice sleeves - A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct crimp tool to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools to remove the terminals from the connectors The J-38125 does not contain wire that is suitable to high temperature exposure. Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature of the same or larger gage size as the original wire when repair damage wire. Also replace any reflective tape that you remove during the repair. HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature rating of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125 and then encapsulate the splice sleeve using the high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the order listed. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip keeping all of the wire strands intact. Page 8196 2. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully push the terminal position assurance (TPA) towards the face of the connector on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA is fragile and may break if not done carefully. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. 3. Use the J 38125-215 tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 4418 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the rear TPA from the connector. 7. IMPORTANT: The front TPA cannot be removed from the connector. Only move it to the release point. Use a small flat-blade tool to move the front TPA to the release position. 8. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 9. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Molex Connectors Page 8313 Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size. REPAIRING A FUSIBLE LINK IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient overload protection. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. Flat Wire Repairs FLAT WIRE REPAIRS NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced. GMLAN Wiring Repairs GMLAN WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The GM Local Area Network (GMLAN) System requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working on GMLAN connectors and terminals. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items in order to repair the GMLAN wiring: Dura Seal splice sleeves - A wire stripping tool - J 38125-8 Crimping Tool (GM P/N 12085115) - J 38125-5 Ultra Torch Special Tool (GM P/N 12085116) The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. - A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors GMLAN REPAIRS IMPORTANT: When making a repair to any GMLAN network, the original wire length after the repair must be the same length as before the repair. If the network is a twisted pair, the twist must be maintained after the repair is completed. GMLAN has 2 types of networks, low speed and high speed. Low speed GMLAN has a single wire and works at slow speeds. High speed GMLAN has 2 wires in a twisted pair and works at higher speeds. For more information on GMLAN, refer to Data Link Communications Description and Operation. GMLAN CONNECTOR TERMINAL REPAIR IMPORTANT: A service terminal can be used to replace damaged connector terminals for both high speed and low speed GMLAN systems. When making a connector terminal repair on a GMLAN high speed system with twisted pair wires, do not untwist the wires more than necessary to make the repair. The terminals in the GMLAN system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are available in the J-38125. If the individual terminals are damaged on any GMLAN connection, use the appropriate connector repair procedure in order to repair the terminal. GMLAN WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 7508 pulling it through. This will prevent damage to the internal seals of the connector. Once the terminal is pushed out of the connector, cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible and pull the wire through the connector. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE The Micro-Pack 100W connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool was developed to crimp Micro-Pack 100W terminals. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 2. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert the terminal into the crimp tool until the core wings are flush with the anvil on the crimp tool. Be sure that the wings are pointed toward the crimp tool former and release the spring locator. The locator will hold the terminal in place. Inspect the alignment of the terminal wings with the crimp tool former. If the terminal wings are wider than the crimp tool former, remove the terminal and bend the terminal wings in slightly. 5. Place stripped wire into terminal. 6. Crimp the new terminal to the wire. If a jam occurs, press the emergency release to open applicator. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire perform the following procedure in order to replace Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. Page 8445 Release the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the blue locking tabs on both ends of the connector. Gently slide the TPA up to the released position on both ends. 6. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-13A (GM P/N 12031876-1) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. Page 1714 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (BSK) BOSCH CONNECTORS (BSK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 3. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 4. Insert the J 38125-561 tool into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 5. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is Page 8003 6. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs located on the opposite side of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover at the connector end and pry up. 7. Remove the dress cover. 8. Cut the tie wrap on the wire bundle. 9. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting a small flat-bladed tool into the small slot in the end of the slider and pushing on the TPA until it comes out of the connector. When the TPA exits the opposite side of the connector, gasp the TPA and pull it completely out of the connector. 10. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 5733 Release the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the blue locking tabs on both ends of the connector. Gently slide the TPA up to the released position on both ends. 6. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-13A (GM P/N 12031876-1) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. Page 7423 Engine Control Module (ECM) C1 (Pin 16 To 56) Engine Control Module (ECM) C2 Page 3599 longer. Important Whenever a wheel is refinished, the mounting surface and the wheel nut contact surfaces must not be painted or clearcoated. Coating these surfaces could affect the wheel nut torque. When re-mounting a tire on an aluminum wheel, coated balance weights must be used in order to reduce the chance of future cosmetic damage. Disclaimer Page 8955 2. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 1767 3. Ensure that the terminal release tang access panel is in the correct location to access the terminals. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) into the terminal release tang access slot located behind the access panel of the connector and press down on the terminal while carefully pulling the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Tyco/AMP Connectors (0.25 Cap) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (025 CAP) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component by pressing down on the connector position assurance (CPA). Page 4024 Engine Mount: Service and Repair Engine Mount Replacement - Right Engine Mount Replacement - Right Side (Two-Wheel Drive) Removal Procedure 1. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 2. Remove the front tire and wheels. Refer to Tire and Wheel Removal and Installation. 3. Remove the engine protection shield. Refer to Engine Protection Shield Replacement. 4. Remove the shock module. Refer to Shock Module Replacement. 5. Remove the lower engine mount retaining nuts from the engine mount frame bracket. 6. Remove the 3 mounting bolts that secure the upper engine mount bracket to the engine block bracket. Page 5664 vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide variety of actions, including: - Wiggling the harness - Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting - Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector - Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation - Relocating a harness or wires All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. Another option is, with the component commanded ON and OFF by the scan tool, move related connectors and wiring and observe the component operation. With the engine running, move related connectors and wiring while monitoring engine operation. If harness or connector movement affects the data displayed, component/system operation, or engine operation, inspect and repair the harness/connections as necessary. You may need to load the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these cases you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide good results as well. There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions, along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the circuit to these kinds of conditions. SALT WATER SPRAY Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture. Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5 percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously. HIGH TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070. Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault condition. The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis. This option does not allow for the same control, however. LOW TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect. If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to -18°C (0°F) from one end and +71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized cooling needs. Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or components in an effort to duplicate the concern. DUPLICATING FAILURE CONDITIONS - If none of the previous tests are successful, attempt to duplicate and/or capture the failure conditions. Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, where applicable, contains the conditions that were present when the DTC set. 1. Review and record Freeze Frame/Failure Records data. 2. Clear the DTCs using the scan tool. 3. Turn the key to OFF and wait 15 seconds. 4. Operate the vehicle under the same conditions that were noted in Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, as closely as possible. The vehicle must also be operating within the Conditions for Running the DTC. Refer to Conditions for Running the DTC in the supporting text if a DTC is being diagnosed. 5. Monitor DTC Status for the DTC being tested. The scan tool will indicate Ran, when the enabling conditions have been satisfied long enough for the DTC to run. The scan tool will also indicate whether the DTC passed or failed. - An alternate method is to drive the vehicle with the DMM connected to a suspected circuit. An abnormal reading on the DMM when the concern occurs, may help you locate the concern. Measuring Frequency Page 4793 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. 4. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front of the connector. Fuel Level Sensor Replacement Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair Fuel Level Sensor Replacement Fuel Level Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Remove the fuel sender assembly. 2. Disconnect the fuel level sensor electrical connector (1). 3. Depress the fuel level sensor retaining tabs (2) to release the sensor from the sender assembly. 4. Remove the fuel level sensor electrical connector (1) and sensor (2) from the fuel sender assembly. Installation Procedure Page 3690 Dinghy towing is permitted on the trucks shown with the transfer case placed in the Neutral position. Refer to the end of this bulletin for identification information to determine type of transfer case. The vehicles shown should NOT be dinghy towed because the transfer cases in these vehicles either have no neutral position or do not have an internal oil pump to provide lubrication while being towed. In order to properly tow the vehicles, place the vehicle on a platform trailer with all four tires off the ground. Avoid towing the vehicle with all four tires on the ground. In rare instances when towing with all four tires on the ground is unavoidable, both the front and the rear propeller shafts must be removed in order to prevent damage to the transfer case and/or transmission. Because front and rear propeller shafts are matched to attaching components at assembly, refer to the applicable Service Manual for procedures on propeller shaft removal/installation. Towing Procedure In order to properly dinghy tow the vehicle, use the following procedure: 1. Firmly set the parking brake. Page 1394 If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs SIR/SRS WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS, and the wiring components, such as connectors and terminals. IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system terminals. Use either an SIR/SRS pigtail or a terminated lead from the SIR Repair Kit Tray. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves, in order to repair the SIR/SRS wiring - A special crimping tool - A heat torch - An instruction manual The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides the necessary low resistance contact integrity for these sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors SIR/SRS CONNECTOR REPAIR (PLASTIC BODY AND TERMINAL METAL PIN) The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made with a special plating. This plating provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. Use the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit for repairing SIR/SRS terminals and connectors. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the repair kit. The J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit contains: Various terminated leads for sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) terminal replacement - Various connector positive assurance (CPA) locks for SIR/SRS connectors - Base of steering column pigtail connectors part number 12085514 - Yellow vinyl electrical tape Pigtail repair packs are available for SIR/SRS connectors with eight or less terminals. Only the connector body is available for connectors with more than eight terminals. The terminated leads in the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit can be used to replace damaged terminals when replacing the connector body. SIR/SRS COMPONENT WIRE PIGTAIL REPAIR IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails. A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device, not by a connector. If a wiring pigtail is damaged, you must replace the entire component, with pigtail. The inflatable restraint steering wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component. SIR/SRS WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 2326 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (BSK) BOSCH CONNECTORS (BSK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 3. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 4. Insert the J 38125-561 tool into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 5. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is Page 4367 vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide variety of actions, including: - Wiggling the harness - Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting - Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector - Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation - Relocating a harness or wires All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. Another option is, with the component commanded ON and OFF by the scan tool, move related connectors and wiring and observe the component operation. With the engine running, move related connectors and wiring while monitoring engine operation. If harness or connector movement affects the data displayed, component/system operation, or engine operation, inspect and repair the harness/connections as necessary. You may need to load the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these cases you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide good results as well. There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions, along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the circuit to these kinds of conditions. SALT WATER SPRAY Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture. Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5 percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously. HIGH TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070. Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault condition. The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis. This option does not allow for the same control, however. LOW TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect. If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to -18°C (0°F) from one end and +71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized cooling needs. Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or components in an effort to duplicate the concern. DUPLICATING FAILURE CONDITIONS - If none of the previous tests are successful, attempt to duplicate and/or capture the failure conditions. Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, where applicable, contains the conditions that were present when the DTC set. 1. Review and record Freeze Frame/Failure Records data. 2. Clear the DTCs using the scan tool. 3. Turn the key to OFF and wait 15 seconds. 4. Operate the vehicle under the same conditions that were noted in Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, as closely as possible. The vehicle must also be operating within the Conditions for Running the DTC. Refer to Conditions for Running the DTC in the supporting text if a DTC is being diagnosed. 5. Monitor DTC Status for the DTC being tested. The scan tool will indicate Ran, when the enabling conditions have been satisfied long enough for the DTC to run. The scan tool will also indicate whether the DTC passed or failed. - An alternate method is to drive the vehicle with the DMM connected to a suspected circuit. An abnormal reading on the DMM when the concern occurs, may help you locate the concern. Measuring Frequency Page 7689 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the DuraSeal splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of a connector. CPAs are used in all SIR System connectors and also in some connectors of other systems. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals of a connection. TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE CLIPS IMPORTANT: When making a splice in an area that may be exposed to moisture use a crimp and seal splice sleeve instead of a Splice Clip. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. Page 5642 Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Specifications Temperature Versus Resistance Page 8668 IMPORTANT: Ensure that the dress cover and connector body are both in the released position before reassembling. Failure to do so may cause damage to the connector and component. Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (0.64) BOSCH CONNECTORS (0.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While pressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock until the lever is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Pull the rubber boot that covers the wires back to expose the end of the connector dress cover. 4. Place the connector locking lever in the center of the connector. 5. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs that are on the wire end of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover and connector body and pry up. Page 2904 Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair Fuel Pressure Gage Installation and Removal Fuel Pressure Gage Installation and Removal Tools Required CH-48027 Digital Pressure Gage Installation Procedure Caution: Refer to Gasoline/Gasoline Vapors Caution. Caution: Remove the fuel tank cap and relieve the fuel system pressure before servicing the fuel system in order to reduce the risk of personal injury. After you relieve the fuel system pressure, a small amount of fuel may be released when servicing the fuel lines, the fuel injection pump, or the connections. In order to reduce the risk of personal injury, cover the fuel system components with a shop towel before disconnection. This will catch any fuel that may leak out. Place the towel in an approved container when the disconnection is complete. 1. Relieve the fuel system pressure. Refer to Fuel Pressure Relief. 2. Connect the CH-48027-1 (1) to the CH-48027-2 (2). 3. Remove the shop towel from around the fuel rail service port, and place in an approved gasoline container. 4. Perform any tests and/or diagnostics as needed. For the proper usage of the CH-48027 , refer to the manufacture's directions. Removal Procedure Page 7626 Connector Anatomy Connector Repairs contains a list of all connector repairs. The connector repairs are listed by the connector manufacturer and then by connector type. If the technician cannot identify the manufacturer of the connector, refer to Identifying Connectors below. Knowing the connector manufacturer will assist in finding the correct connector repair from the following list: - Connector Position Assurance Locks - Terminal Position Assurance Locks - Bosch Connectors (0.64) Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) Bosch Connectors (BSK) Bosch Connectors (ECM) - Delphi Connectors (Micro.64) Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) Delphi Connectors (12-Way) - Tyco/AMP Connectors (CM 42-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) Tyco/AMP Connectors (025 Cap) Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) - Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) - Repairing Connector Terminals IDENTIFYING CONNECTORS Knowing the connector manufacturer is helpful when trying to locating the correct connector repair procedure. There are many different connector designs used on GM vehicles and it is sometimes difficult to identify the connector manufacturer. The information in this document should help with the identification of connector manufactures. The following connector manufacturers make most of the connectors found in GM vehicles: AFL/EPC (Alcoa Fujikura Ltd./Engineered Plastics Components) - Bosch - Delphi - FCI (Framatome Connectors International) - JAE (Japan Aviation Electronics) - JST (Japan Solderless Terminals) Page 5570 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. JST Connectors JST CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, remove the connector from the component. Page 5205 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. 4. Remove the dress cover by using a flat bladed tool to release the dress cover locking tabs and lift up on the dress cover. 5. Cut the tie wrap that holds the wires to the connector body. Page 2253 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the rear TPA from the connector. 7. IMPORTANT: The front TPA cannot be removed from the connector. Only move it to the release point. Use a small flat-blade tool to move the front TPA to the release position. 8. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 9. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Molex Connectors Page 4910 - Kostel - Molex - Sumitomo - Tyco/AMP - Yazaki Identifying the manufacturer of a connector is often difficult. When trying to determine the manufacturer of a connector, look for specific identifying marks that are unique to that connector supplier. Most of these identify marks are hard to find or see. Check the connector carefully and refer to the information below for pictures and descriptions of connector identification markings. - Most of AFLs connectors have EPC on their connector body. Some of the smaller connectors will not have any markings on them. - In some cases Bosch will actually be printed on the connector. If Bosch does not appear on the connector, look for the Bosch logo. The Bosch logo is a circle with a blunted arrow inside. This logo can appear anywhere on the connector and is often very small. Page 5985 2. Locate the two indents of the terminal position assurance (TPA) located on the bottom of the connector body. Page 2377 4. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the rear of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. 5. Once the locking tabs are unlocked, slide the inner connector out of the rear of the connector housing. Page 5717 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. 4. Remove the dress cover by using a flat bladed tool to release the dress cover locking tabs and lift up on the dress cover. 5. Cut the tie wrap that holds the wires to the connector body. Page 648 Note The dealer will receive an e-mail reply after the calibrations have been validated. The e-mail reply will advise the dealer if the calibrations are OEM. 28. Allow two hours for the PQC to verify the calibrations and set up the case details. ‹› If the PQC determines that the calibrations ARE aftermarket calibrations, DO NOT contact GM Technical Assistance to discuss warranty concerns on the aftermarket calibrations. ALL questions and concerns about warranty should be directed to the dealers Fixed Operations Manager (FOM), (Warranty Manager (WM) in Canada). 29. You may call the PQC two hours after submitting the e-mail for authorization to replace the assembly. This will provide them time to receive, review and set up a case on the request. Please be prepared to provide all the usual documentation that is normally required when requesting an assembly authorization from the PQC. Warranty Information - The Dealership Service Management must be involved in any situation that would justify the use of labor operation Z1111. - Notify the Fixed Operations Manager (FOM) (Warranty Manager (WM) in Canada) of the situation. - All claims will have to be routed to the FOM (WM in Canada) for approval. - Please refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 09-00-89-016, Labor Operation Z1111 - Suspected Tampering or Vehicle Modifications for important information. For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table above. Disclaimer Page 8722 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert a small flat-blade tool in the slot below the front loaded terminal position assurance (TPA) and pry up. 3. Remove the TPA by pulling it out of the connector. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-553 (GM P/N 15315247) on a slight upward angle into the cavity below the terminal to be removed. Ensure that the pointed on the end of the tool is facing the bottom of the terminal and it stays in contact with the terminal until it stops on the plastic terminal retainer. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 8663 Release the tabs that are holding the wiredress cover to the connector body. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the slots on both ends of the connector body. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. J 38125-216 can also be used to remove the nose piece. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by lifting the terminal retaining tabs on the inside of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 1372 9. The illustration shows a cutaway view of the connector to aid the technician in releasing the terminal retainer. 10. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Terminal Position Assurance Locks TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Tyco/Amp Connectors (CM 42-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (CM 42-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the connector body and pull the CPA out. The CPA is on the wire harness side of connector. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 5178 - Yazaki has a wedge or arrow shape, similar to that shown. Delphi Connectors (Micro .64) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro 64 connectors. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. The lever lock may be located on the top or sides of the wire dress cover. Page 367 3. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. View showing depressing of the lever lock release tab. Page 2294 Page 4412 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. JST Connectors JST CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, remove the connector from the component. Page 4889 MEASURING FREQUENCY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal. IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM to autorange to an appropriate range. 1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency measured. Measuring Voltage MEASURING VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit. 1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods: - Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. - Turn ON the engine. - Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls. - Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested. 3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The DMM displays the voltage measured at that point. Measuring Voltage Drop MEASURING VOLTAGE DROP NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points. Probing Electrical Connectors PROBING ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS Page 8785 Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested: - Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. - Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a component or to other harnesses. - If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A TEST LAMP TOOLS REQUIRED J 35616-200 Test Light - Probe Kit NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminate even though voltage is present. The J 35616-200 is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair of leads. To properly operate this tool use the following procedures. When testing for voltage: 1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested. When testing for ground: 1. Attach one lead to battery positive voltage. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where ground should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is ground at the point being tested. Using Connector Test Adapters USING CONNECTOR TEST ADAPTERS NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Using Fused Jumper Wires USING FUSED JUMPER WIRES TOOLS REQUIRED J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged. The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested. AFL/ECP Connectors AFL/EPC CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 6667 Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. For connectors with a bolt in the dress cover, turn the bolt counterclockwise to remove the connector from the component. 2. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. Locations Traction Control Switch: Locations Antilock Brake System Component Views Floor Shift Control Knob 1 - Traction Control Switch Page 6186 Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Page 7855 1. Connect the HO2S electrical connector (3). 2. Install the CPA retainer. Important: A special anti-seize compound is used on the HO2S threads. The compound consists of liquid graphite and glass beads. The graphite tends to burn away, but the glass beads remain, making the sensor easier to remove. New, or service replacement sensors already have the compound applied to the threads. If the sensor is removed from an exhaust component and if for any reason the sensor is to be reinstalled, the threads must have anti-seize compound applied before the reinstallation. 3. If reinstalling the old sensor, coat the threads with anti-seize compound GM P/N 12377953, or equivalent. Notice: Refer to Component Fastener Tightening Notice. Important: If the HO2S sensor is connected to the main wiring harness during installation. Rotate the HO2S sensor several turns counterclockwise before threading the HO2S sensor into the catalytic converter. This action of initially reverse winding of the pigtail wires will prevent a condition where the HO2S sensor pigtail wires become severely twisted or binding once the HO2S sensor is installed into the catalytic converter. 4. Install the HO2S (2). Tighten the sensor to 42 N.m (31 lb ft). 5. Lower the vehicle. Page 6148 If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the DuraSeal splice sleeves. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: - Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. - Do not use the crimp and DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 to crimp DuraSeal splice sleeve. In order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 2031 6. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by pressing on the tang. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (SENSOR) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) tool into the cavity on the lower right hand face of the connector until the terminal release tang access panel slides over. Page 8074 5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape. Seat Belt Schematic Icons Seat Belt Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons Page 7422 Engine Control Module (ECM) C1 (Pin 1 To 15) Page 9039 The first connector design of the Micro-Pack 100W (1) has a white connector interface that holds the terminals. The second design of the Micro-Pack 100W (2) has a gray interface to hold the terminals. Also, the first design has terminal cavities that are further apart (3 mm centerline) and offset from the other row of terminal cavities in the connector. The second design has terminals cavities that are closer together (2.54 mm centerline) and aligned vertically. One other way to identify the second design is the thin strip of material that runs along the outside of the cavities. IMPORTANT: There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W terminals which are very similar. Ensure that you have the correct terminal before crimping the new terminal to the wire. The first design connector uses the longer terminal (1) that has a raised area in front of the recess in the terminal. The second design connector uses the shorter terminal without the raised area. Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro-Pack 100W connectors. Some Micro-Pack 100W connector disassembly procedures will vary. Use this procedure as a guide. 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 3087 For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table above. Disclaimer Page 2153 4. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the rear of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. 5. Once the locking tabs are unlocked, slide the inner connector out of the rear of the connector housing. Page 8822 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. JST Connectors JST CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, remove the connector from the component. Page 4857 The engine harness may be repaired using the J-38125. High Temperature Wiring Repairs HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperatures, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time may use materials i.e. wires, connectors, and shielding that has a higher heat rating than typical wiring. When making a repair in a high temperature area observe the following: Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature to replace any damaged wire. - Replace any heat shielding that is removed. - Cover any DuraSeal splice sleeves with SCT1 shrink tubing (available in the J-38125 Terminal Repair kit). - After making a wiring repair, ensure that the location of the wiring is not moved closer to the heat source. IDENTIFYING HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperature, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time need special considerations when making wiring repairs. Areas that may be exposed to higher temperatures can be identified by heat resistant materials that are being used in those areas. These materials may include heat reflective tape, moon tape, and high temperature shrink tubing. Also conduit and other protective coverings may be used. Because conduit or similar coverings are used throughout the vehicle regardless of the temperature, it may be necessary for the technician to determine if an area is exposed to excessive heat before making a wiring repair. Obvious areas of consideration would be any area located near the exhaust manifolds, catalytic converter, and exhaust pipes. The J-38125 contains much of the material you will need to perform repairs on areas exposed to high heat. The kit contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves to crimp and seal connections - High temperature SCT1 shrink tubing to protect the splice sleeves - A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct crimp tool to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools to remove the terminals from the connectors The J-38125 does not contain wire that is suitable to high temperature exposure. Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature of the same or larger gage size as the original wire when repair damage wire. Also replace any reflective tape that you remove during the repair. HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature rating of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125 and then encapsulate the splice sleeve using the high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the order listed. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip keeping all of the wire strands intact. Page 3408 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 7388 9. The illustration shows a cutaway view of the connector to aid the technician in releasing the terminal retainer. 10. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Terminal Position Assurance Locks TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Tyco/Amp Connectors (CM 42-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (CM 42-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the connector body and pull the CPA out. The CPA is on the wire harness side of connector. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 5072 Body Control Module (BCM) C2 Page 5354 3. Ensure that the terminal release tang access panel is in the correct location to access the terminals. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) into the terminal release tang access slot located behind the access panel of the connector and press down on the terminal while carefully pulling the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Tyco/AMP Connectors (0.25 Cap) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (025 CAP) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component by pressing down on the connector position assurance (CPA). Page 6923 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Kostal Connectors KOSTAL CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 8181 5. Once the nose piece retainers are relaxed, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should raise slightly. 6. On the opposite side of the nose piece, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should release completely. If the nose piece does not come off, repeat the procedure on the opposite side. Page 7081 Release the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the blue locking tabs on both ends of the connector. Gently slide the TPA up to the released position on both ends. 6. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-13A (GM P/N 12031876-1) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. Page 3855 For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 5279 Page 6992 8. Disconnect the 32-way tan electrical connector (2) from the BCM. 9. Disconnect the 24-way gray electrical connector (1) from the BCM. 10. With an upward motion, remove the BCM (1) from the rear electrical center. INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 1. Index the slots on the BCM (1) to the rear electrical center. 2. Using a downward motion, install the BCM to the rear electrical center. 3. Connect the 24-way gray electrical connector (1) to the BCM. 4. Connect the 32-way tan electrical connector (2) to the BCM. 5. Connect the 40-way body wiring extension (1) to the BCM. Page 2360 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully raise the TPA on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA cannot be removed from the connector while there are terminals present in the connector body. View of the TPA when removed from the connector body. 4. Use the J 38125-12A tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the left side of the terminal release cavity as shown in the graphic. Use the tool to move the terminal release to the right with a gentle prying motion. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 719 The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors. 1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position. 4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool J 38125-10A (GM P/N 12014012-1) into the front (mating end) of the connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal through the back of the connector (2). IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector. 6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. 7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily. 10. Perform system check. Delphi Connectors (12 Way) DELPHI CONNECTORS (12-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. Page 7426 Engine Control Module (ECM) C2 (Pin 55 To 73) Engine Control Module (ECM) C3 Page 1433 - A control module from another vehicle is installed. - Revised software/calibration files have been released for this vehicle. - IMPORTANT: DO NOT re-program the control module with the SAME software/calibration files that are already present in the control module. This is not an effective repair for any type of concern. Verify that the control module contains the correct software/calibration. If incorrect programming is found, reprogram the control module with the most current software/calibration. Refer to Control Module References for replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Testing for Short to Ground TESTING FOR SHORT TO GROUND NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 4. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit. With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is a short to ground in the circuit. Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2. Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). - When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. - If the DMM does not display voltage 4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is shorted. Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A DIGITAL MULTIMETER NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the powertrain control module (PCM), should only be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200 Digital Multimeter (DMM). The J 39200 instruction manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminage even though voltage is present. The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity. IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading. Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the measurement. Page 8570 5. Once the nose piece retainers are relaxed, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should raise slightly. 6. On the opposite side of the nose piece, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should release completely. If the nose piece does not come off, repeat the procedure on the opposite side. Page 4631 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. JST Connectors JST CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, remove the connector from the component. Page 5024 14. Install the air cleaner outlet duct and bolt. Tighten the bolt to 10 N.m (89 lb in). 15. Tighten the air cleaner outlet duct clamps at the following locations: ^ Throttle body ^ MAF/IAT sensor Tighten the clamps to 7 N.m (62 lb in). 16. Fill the cooling system. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System (LL8) Draining and Filling Cooling System (LH6, LS2). Page 8958 3. Ensure that the terminal release tang access panel is in the correct location to access the terminals. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) into the terminal release tang access slot located behind the access panel of the connector and press down on the terminal while carefully pulling the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Tyco/AMP Connectors (0.25 Cap) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (025 CAP) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component by pressing down on the connector position assurance (CPA). Page 8368 Page 2190 Page 839 - Kostel - Molex - Sumitomo - Tyco/AMP - Yazaki Identifying the manufacturer of a connector is often difficult. When trying to determine the manufacturer of a connector, look for specific identifying marks that are unique to that connector supplier. Most of these identify marks are hard to find or see. Check the connector carefully and refer to the information below for pictures and descriptions of connector identification markings. - Most of AFLs connectors have EPC on their connector body. Some of the smaller connectors will not have any markings on them. - In some cases Bosch will actually be printed on the connector. If Bosch does not appear on the connector, look for the Bosch logo. The Bosch logo is a circle with a blunted arrow inside. This logo can appear anywhere on the connector and is often very small. Page 1600 pulling it through. This will prevent damage to the internal seals of the connector. Once the terminal is pushed out of the connector, cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible and pull the wire through the connector. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE The Micro-Pack 100W connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool was developed to crimp Micro-Pack 100W terminals. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 2. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert the terminal into the crimp tool until the core wings are flush with the anvil on the crimp tool. Be sure that the wings are pointed toward the crimp tool former and release the spring locator. The locator will hold the terminal in place. Inspect the alignment of the terminal wings with the crimp tool former. If the terminal wings are wider than the crimp tool former, remove the terminal and bend the terminal wings in slightly. 5. Place stripped wire into terminal. 6. Crimp the new terminal to the wire. If a jam occurs, press the emergency release to open applicator. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire perform the following procedure in order to replace Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. Page 6345 4. Use a small flat-blade tool to slide the terminal position assurance (TPA) up one notch on both ends of the connector. The TPA is located underneath the wire dress cover. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 7339 View of connector in released position. 4. Disconnect the connector from the component. 5. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Release the rear lower half of the wiredress cover. Page 2147 5. Once the nose piece retainers are relaxed, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should raise slightly. 6. On the opposite side of the nose piece, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should release completely. If the nose piece does not come off, repeat the procedure on the opposite side. Specifications Spark Plug: Specifications Spark Plug Gap ................................................................................................................................... ...................................................... 1.02 mm (0.040in) Spark Plug Torque ......................................... ............................................................................................................................................. 15 N.m (11 lb ft) Page 647 3. Connect the MDI to a PC or laptop that has been downloaded with the GDS application from TIS2WEB. Note At least one Diagnostic Package must be installed on the PC to perform diagnostics. If GDS was just installed, select: Add New Diagnostic Package and then select: a Diagnostic Package to download. 4. Click: On the GDS icon on the PC. 5. The Login Page will appear. 6. Select: A User. 7. The ID Screen will appear. 8. Select: The serial number of the MDI being used. 9. Select: Connect. 10. Verify that the system status is ready by observing for a flashing PC light icon on the MDI. 11. Select: Make, Model and Model Year, in order to build the vehicle. 12. Click: Upload VIN, to allow the VIN to be reported to the PC. 13. At: The Verification step, turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. 14. Select: Next Action. 15. The Home Page will appear. 16. Select: Next. 17. The Diagnostic Screen will appear. Note Due to vehicle build, software and RPO variations, GDS may ask for additional information in Step 18. 18. Select: Engine ID, if prompted. 19. Select: Module Diagnostics. 20. Select: ECM. 21. Select: ID Information. 22. The Diagnostics page will appear. Typical View of GDS Calibration History Screen Note GDS is capable of displaying up to 10 Calibration History events. 23. Select: Calibration History from the drop down menu in order to display the following items on the screen: - Calibration History Buffer - Number of Calibration History Events Stored - Calibration Part Number History - Calibration Verification Number History 24. Select: Screenshot. 25. Name and save the file in an appropriate folder. 26. Select : Print, and retain a copy of the screenshot with the repair order. 27. E-mail a copy of the screenshot to [email protected]. In the subject line of the e-mail include the phrase "V8 Cal" as well as the complete VIN and Dealer BAC. In the body of the e-mail, include the VIN, mileage, R.O. number and BAC. Include a brief description of the customer concern and cause of the concern. Page 8723 6. Gently pry the plastic terminal retainer down and carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (16-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, pull the two connector halves apart. Page 2895 Disclaimer Page 1485 7. The illustration above identifies the entry canal where the terminal release tool will be inserted, and the terminal cavity. - Terminal (1) - Entry Canal (2) 8. Insert the J-38125-553 (15315247) tool into the entry canal and pry up on the terminal retainer. The terminal retainer is a small plastic piece on the top of the terminal. The terminal retainer must be held up while the terminal is pulled out of the connector. Page 3953 * The hose connections * The areas surrounding the connections Disconnect the CH-48027-2 (2) from the CH-48027-3 (4). 11. Disconnect the CH-48027-3 (4) from the fuel rail service port. 12. Remove the shop towel from around the fuel rail service port, and place in an approved gasoline container. 13. Install the fuel rail service port cap. 14. Install the engine cover, if required. 15. Tighten the fuel fill cap. Without CH-48027 Caution: Refer to Gasoline/Gasoline Vapors Caution. Caution: Remove the fuel tank cap and relieve the fuel system pressure before servicing the fuel system in order to reduce the risk of personal injury. After you relieve the fuel system pressure, a small amount of fuel may be released when servicing the fuel lines, the fuel injection pump, or the connections. In order to reduce the risk of personal injury, cover the fuel system components with a shop towel before disconnection. This will catch any fuel that may leak out. Place the towel in an approved container when the disconnection is complete. 1. Loosen the fuel fill cap in order to relieve the fuel tank vapor pressure. 2. Remove the engine cover, if required. 3. Remove the fuel rail service port cap. 4. Wrap a shop towel around the fuel rail service port and using a small flat bladed tool, depress (open) the fuel rail test port valve. 5. Remove the shop towel from around the fuel rail service port, and place in an approved gasoline container. 6. Install the fuel rail service port cap. 7. Install the engine cover, if required. 8. Tighten the fuel fill cap. Page 8048 2. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 5581 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 7969 Disclaimer Page 4847 Release the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the blue locking tabs on both ends of the connector. Gently slide the TPA up to the released position on both ends. 6. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-13A (GM P/N 12031876-1) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. Page 4469 Locations Control Module: Locations Transmission Control Module (TCM) Transmission Control Module (TCM) 1 - Engine Harness 2 - Transmission Control Module (TCM) 3 - Transmission Control Module (TCM) Connector Harness Page 3175 Engine Oil: Capacity Specifications Engine Oil with Filter ............................................................................................................................ ............................................... 6.0 quarts (5.7 liters) NOTE: All capacities are approximate. When adding, be sure to fill to the approximate level. Recheck fluid level after filling. Page 4122 Installation Procedure 1. Wipe the excess oil from the oil filter mounting. 2. Lubricate the oil filter seal with clean engine oil. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 3. Install the oil filter to the oil pan. Tighten the filter to 30 N.m (22 lb ft). 4. Wipe the excess oil from the drain plug hole. 5. Install the oil drain plug to the oil pan. Tighten the oil pan drain plug to 25 N.m (18 lb ft). Page 6374 2. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully push the terminal position assurance (TPA) towards the face of the connector on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA is fragile and may break if not done carefully. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. 3. Use the J 38125-215 tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 7990 If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200 DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J 39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected. IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J 39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and maximum (MAX) values measured. 1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of a suspected circuit to the other. 2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J 39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep). IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value in order to record the full change. 5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling the connections or the wiring, test driving, or performing other operations. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions. 6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9. Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist. Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections TESTING FOR INTERMITTENT CONDITIONS AND POOR CONNECTIONS TOOLS REQUIRED - J 35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit - J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit When the condition is not currently present, but is indicated in DTC history, the cause may be intermittent. An intermittent may also be the cause when there is a customer complaint, but the symptom cannot be duplicated. Refer to the Symptom Table of the system that is suspect of causing the condition before trying to locate an intermittent condition. Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the following items: Wiring broken inside the insulation - Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector - Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself, and corrosion in the wire to terminal contact area, etc. - Pierced or damaged insulation can allow moisture to enter the wiring causing corrosion. The conductor can corrode inside the insulation, with little visible evidence. Look for swollen and stiff sections of wire in the suspect circuits. - Wiring which has been pinched, cut, or its insulation rubbed through may cause an intermittent open or short as the bare area touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle. - Wiring that comes in contact with hot or exhaust components - Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required, in order to verify the customer concern. - Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. - Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis and Vehicle Data Recorder operation. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any inline connectors before replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation. Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination, usually in the underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit. Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper adapter. Always use the J 35616 when probing connectors. Other causes of terminal deformation are improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT IN BUSSED ELECTRICAL CENTERS (BEC) Page 2272 View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. View of the release tool being used for the smaller terminals. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (2-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 5288 vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide variety of actions, including: - Wiggling the harness - Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting - Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector - Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation - Relocating a harness or wires All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. Another option is, with the component commanded ON and OFF by the scan tool, move related connectors and wiring and observe the component operation. With the engine running, move related connectors and wiring while monitoring engine operation. If harness or connector movement affects the data displayed, component/system operation, or engine operation, inspect and repair the harness/connections as necessary. You may need to load the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these cases you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide good results as well. There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions, along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the circuit to these kinds of conditions. SALT WATER SPRAY Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture. Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5 percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously. HIGH TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070. Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault condition. The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis. This option does not allow for the same control, however. LOW TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect. If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to -18°C (0°F) from one end and +71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized cooling needs. Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or components in an effort to duplicate the concern. DUPLICATING FAILURE CONDITIONS - If none of the previous tests are successful, attempt to duplicate and/or capture the failure conditions. Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, where applicable, contains the conditions that were present when the DTC set. 1. Review and record Freeze Frame/Failure Records data. 2. Clear the DTCs using the scan tool. 3. Turn the key to OFF and wait 15 seconds. 4. Operate the vehicle under the same conditions that were noted in Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, as closely as possible. The vehicle must also be operating within the Conditions for Running the DTC. Refer to Conditions for Running the DTC in the supporting text if a DTC is being diagnosed. 5. Monitor DTC Status for the DTC being tested. The scan tool will indicate Ran, when the enabling conditions have been satisfied long enough for the DTC to run. The scan tool will also indicate whether the DTC passed or failed. - An alternate method is to drive the vehicle with the DMM connected to a suspected circuit. An abnormal reading on the DMM when the concern occurs, may help you locate the concern. Measuring Frequency Engine Controls - MIL ON/Misfire/Misfire DTC's Set Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Engine Controls - MIL ON/Misfire/Misfire DTC's Set Bulletin No.: 06-06-04-046 Date: September 12, 2006 INFORMATION Subject: Information on Engine Misfire MIL/SES Light Illuminated or Flashing DTC P0300, P0301, P0302, P0303, P0304, P0305, P0306, P0307, P0308, P0420 or P0430 Models: 1999-2007 Cadillac, Chevrolet, GMC Full-Size Pickup and/or Utility Trucks with 4.8L, 5.3L, 5.7L, 6.0L or 6.2L VORTEC GEN III, GEN IV, V-8 Engine (VINs V, C, T, Z, B, 3, M, 0, J, R, U, N, Y, K, 8 - RPOs LR4, LY2, LM7, L59, L33, LC9, LH6, LMG, LY5, L31, LQ4, LQ9, L76, LY6, L92) with Active Fuel Management(TM) and E85 Flex Fuel If you encounter vehicles that exhibit the above conditions, refer to SI for the appropriate DTC(s) set. If no trouble is found, the cause may be due to an ECM ground terminal that has corroded with rust over time. Inspect the main engine wiring harness ground terminal (G103) for this condition. The wire terminal (G103) attaches either to the front or to the rear of the right side cylinder head, depending on the model year of the Full Size Pickup and/or Utility Trucks. If the ECM ground terminal has been found to be corroded, then follow the service procedure outlined in this bulletin to correct the corrosion issue. Remove either the nut or bolt securing the main engine wiring harness ground terminal (G103) to the right cylinder head. Refer to the above illustration to determine where the ground is located on the vehicle (1). Page 7830 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Start in the middle and gradually move the heat barrel to the open ends of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Heated Oxygen Sensor Wiring Repairs HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being obstructed. If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. - Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks, etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire. - Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance. - To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector. Page 2080 Tire Monitor System - TPM Sensor Information Tire Pressure Monitor Receiver / Transponder: Technical Service Bulletins Tire Monitor System TPM Sensor Information INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 08-03-16-003 Date: May 12, 2008 Subject: Warranty Reduction - Transfer of Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensors to Replacement Wheels and Allowable TPM Sensor Replacements Models: 2000-2009 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2003-2009 HUMMER H2 2006-2009 HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7x with On-Wheel TPM Sensors TPM Sensor / Wheel Warranty Reviews During the last warranty review period it was noted that wheels being returned under the GM New Vehicle Warranty were being shipped back to General Motors with the TPM sensor still attached to the wheel. Return rates ran as high as 60% with the TPM sensors still attached. Operational TPM sensors should not be returned to GM and are to be transferred to replacement wheels if they become necessary. Important: Operational TPM Sensors that are returned under warranty to General Motors will be charged back to the dealer.Sensors have a 10 year /150,000 mile (240,000 km) battery life, and should be transferred if one or more wheels are replaced. TPM Valve Stem / Grommet (0-ring) Replacement When the TPM sensors are transferred to new wheels you should replace the component used to seal the TPM sensor stem to the wheel. On sensors with an aluminum stem and visible nut on the outside of the wheel a replacement grommet (0-ring) should be used to assure a proper seal. The sensor retaining nut (except Aveo) should be tightened to 7 N.m (62 lb in) for all vehicles except Pontiac Vibe (4.0 N.m (35.4 lb in)). Important: ^ DO NOT overtorque the retaining nut. Notice: ^ Factory installed TPM Sensors come with plastic aluminum or nickel-plated brass stem caps. These caps should not be changed. Chrome plated steel caps may cause corrosion of aluminum valve stems due to incompatibility of the metals. On current style sensors the entire rubber stem is replaceable. The service interval on the revised TPM sensor with replaceable stem is the same as for any other traditional valve stem. Replace the stem at the time of tire replacement sensor transfer or whenever air seepage is suspected at the valve stem. When replacing the valve stem tighten the screw to 1.3 N.m (11.5 lb in). For either style of TPM sensor see the service parts guide for the correct GM part numbers to order and use. Disclaimer Page 6697 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) and slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. Page 2575 5. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove TPA from the connector. 6. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Crankshaft Position Sensor Replacement Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Crankshaft Position Sensor Replacement Crankshaft Position Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure Important: Perform Crankshaft Position System Variation Learn whenever the crankshaft position (CKP) sensor is removed or replaced. 1. Remove the starter. 2. Disconnect the electrical connector (2) from the CKP sensor (1). 3. Clean the area around the CKP sensor before removal in order to avoid debris from entering the engine. 4. Remove the CKP sensor bolt. 5. Remove the CKP sensor. Installation Procedure Page 354 Tire Pressure Sensor Grommet Replacement Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Sensor Grommet Replacement Tire Pressure Sensor Grommet Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Raise the vehicle on a suitable support. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 2. Remove the tire/wheel assembly from the vehicle. Refer to Tire and Wheel Removal and Installation. Important: Before the tire is removed from the wheel, note the following items to avoid tire pressure sensor damage upon tire dismounting: ^ Place the sensors cap and valve on a dry clean surface after removal, the cap is aluminum and the valve is nickel plated to prevent corrosion and are not to be substituted with a cap or valve made of any other material. ^ Position the bead breaking fixture 90 degrees from the valve stem when separating the tire bead from the wheel. ^ Position the mounting/dismounting head so the tire iron, or pry bar can be inserted slightly clockwise of the sensor body when prying the tire bead up and over the mounting/dismounting head. ^ Using the tire machine, rotate the tire/wheel assembly clockwise when transferring the tire bead to the outside of the wheel rim. ^ Repeat items for inner bead. Remove the tire from the wheel. Refer to Tire Mounting and Dismounting. Important: If any tire sealant is noted upon tire dismounting, replace the sensor. Refer to Tire Pressure Sensor Replacement. Also remove all residual liquid sealant from the inside of the tire and wheel surfaces. ^ Remove the tire pressure sensor nut. ^ Remove the sensor from the wheel hole. ^ Remove the sensor grommet from the valve stem. Installation Procedure 1. Clean any dirt or debris from the grommet sealing areas. 2. Install the grommet on the sensor valve stem. Page 3317 If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs SIR/SRS WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS, and the wiring components, such as connectors and terminals. IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system terminals. Use either an SIR/SRS pigtail or a terminated lead from the SIR Repair Kit Tray. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves, in order to repair the SIR/SRS wiring - A special crimping tool - A heat torch - An instruction manual The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides the necessary low resistance contact integrity for these sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors SIR/SRS CONNECTOR REPAIR (PLASTIC BODY AND TERMINAL METAL PIN) The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made with a special plating. This plating provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. Use the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit for repairing SIR/SRS terminals and connectors. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the repair kit. The J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit contains: Various terminated leads for sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) terminal replacement - Various connector positive assurance (CPA) locks for SIR/SRS connectors - Base of steering column pigtail connectors part number 12085514 - Yellow vinyl electrical tape Pigtail repair packs are available for SIR/SRS connectors with eight or less terminals. Only the connector body is available for connectors with more than eight terminals. The terminated leads in the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit can be used to replace damaged terminals when replacing the connector body. SIR/SRS COMPONENT WIRE PIGTAIL REPAIR IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails. A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device, not by a connector. If a wiring pigtail is damaged, you must replace the entire component, with pigtail. The inflatable restraint steering wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component. SIR/SRS WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 1337 - Most Molex connectors will have the Molex logo on the dresscover of the connector. In some cases the connectors may have MX followed by another letter. The third letter indicates where the connector was made. A connector with MXD is a Molex connector made in Detroit. Sumitomo has a unique symbol on their connector and possibly a part number. The symbol is similar to that of a diamond lying on its side, similar to that shown. The logo could appear anywhere but the most common place is at the wire side of the housing. Tyco/AMP has many different and unique connector designs. Some may or may not have identifiable marks on them. Page 6090 - Most Molex connectors will have the Molex logo on the dresscover of the connector. In some cases the connectors may have MX followed by another letter. The third letter indicates where the connector was made. A connector with MXD is a Molex connector made in Detroit. Sumitomo has a unique symbol on their connector and possibly a part number. The symbol is similar to that of a diamond lying on its side, similar to that shown. The logo could appear anywhere but the most common place is at the wire side of the housing. Tyco/AMP has many different and unique connector designs. Some may or may not have identifiable marks on them. Page 3989 Drive Belt: Service Precautions Belt Dressing Notice Notice: Do not use belt dressing on the drive belt. Belt dressing causes the breakdown of the composition of the drive belt. Failure to follow this recommendation will damage the drive belt. Page 6700 Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. FCI Connectors FCI CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 229 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the rear TPA from the connector. 7. IMPORTANT: The front TPA cannot be removed from the connector. Only move it to the release point. Use a small flat-blade tool to move the front TPA to the release position. 8. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 9. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Molex Connectors Page 686 If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200 DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J 39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected. IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J 39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and maximum (MAX) values measured. 1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of a suspected circuit to the other. 2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J 39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep). IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value in order to record the full change. 5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling the connections or the wiring, test driving, or performing other operations. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions. 6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9. Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist. Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections TESTING FOR INTERMITTENT CONDITIONS AND POOR CONNECTIONS TOOLS REQUIRED - J 35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit - J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit When the condition is not currently present, but is indicated in DTC history, the cause may be intermittent. An intermittent may also be the cause when there is a customer complaint, but the symptom cannot be duplicated. Refer to the Symptom Table of the system that is suspect of causing the condition before trying to locate an intermittent condition. Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the following items: Wiring broken inside the insulation - Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector - Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself, and corrosion in the wire to terminal contact area, etc. - Pierced or damaged insulation can allow moisture to enter the wiring causing corrosion. The conductor can corrode inside the insulation, with little visible evidence. Look for swollen and stiff sections of wire in the suspect circuits. - Wiring which has been pinched, cut, or its insulation rubbed through may cause an intermittent open or short as the bare area touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle. - Wiring that comes in contact with hot or exhaust components - Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required, in order to verify the customer concern. - Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. - Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis and Vehicle Data Recorder operation. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any inline connectors before replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation. Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination, usually in the underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit. Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper adapter. Always use the J 35616 when probing connectors. Other causes of terminal deformation are improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT IN BUSSED ELECTRICAL CENTERS (BEC) Page 6018 The engine harness may be repaired using the J-38125. High Temperature Wiring Repairs HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperatures, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time may use materials i.e. wires, connectors, and shielding that has a higher heat rating than typical wiring. When making a repair in a high temperature area observe the following: Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature to replace any damaged wire. - Replace any heat shielding that is removed. - Cover any DuraSeal splice sleeves with SCT1 shrink tubing (available in the J-38125 Terminal Repair kit). - After making a wiring repair, ensure that the location of the wiring is not moved closer to the heat source. IDENTIFYING HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperature, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time need special considerations when making wiring repairs. Areas that may be exposed to higher temperatures can be identified by heat resistant materials that are being used in those areas. These materials may include heat reflective tape, moon tape, and high temperature shrink tubing. Also conduit and other protective coverings may be used. Because conduit or similar coverings are used throughout the vehicle regardless of the temperature, it may be necessary for the technician to determine if an area is exposed to excessive heat before making a wiring repair. Obvious areas of consideration would be any area located near the exhaust manifolds, catalytic converter, and exhaust pipes. The J-38125 contains much of the material you will need to perform repairs on areas exposed to high heat. The kit contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves to crimp and seal connections - High temperature SCT1 shrink tubing to protect the splice sleeves - A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct crimp tool to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools to remove the terminals from the connectors The J-38125 does not contain wire that is suitable to high temperature exposure. Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature of the same or larger gage size as the original wire when repair damage wire. Also replace any reflective tape that you remove during the repair. HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature rating of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125 and then encapsulate the splice sleeve using the high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the order listed. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip keeping all of the wire strands intact. Page 5736 6. Gently pry the plastic terminal retainer down and carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (16-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, pull the two connector halves apart. Page 7899 8. Take a CLEAR digital picture of the Tech 2(R) Vehicle Information screen showing the engine Calibration IDs and Verification Numbers as shown above. Retain the printout information and the Tech 2(R) screen photograph with the repair order. Note All pictures must be sent as a.jpg file. 9. E-mail a copy of the picture to [email protected]. In the subject line of the e-mail include the phrase "V8 Cal" as well as the complete VIN and Dealer BAC. In the body of the e-mail, include the VIN, mileage, R.O. number and BAC. Include a brief description of the customer concern and cause of the concern. Note The dealer will receive an e-mail reply after the calibrations have been validated. The e-mail reply will advise the dealer if the calibrations are OEM. 10. Allow two hours for the PQC to verify the calibrations and set up the case details. ‹› If the PQC determines that the calibrations ARE aftermarket calibrations, DO NOT contact GM Technical Assistance to discuss warranty concerns on the aftermarket calibrations. ALL questions and concerns about warranty should be directed to the dealers Fixed Operations Manager (FOM), (Warranty Manager (WM) in Canada). 11. You may call the PQC two hours after submitting the e-mail for authorization to replace the assembly. This will provide them time to receive, review and set up a case on the request. Please be prepared to provide all the usual documentation that is normally required when requesting an assembly authorization from the PQC. Tech 2(R) Displaying All Zeroes for the Verification Numbers on the Calibration ID and Verification Number Screen If the Tech 2(R) that you are using displays all zeroes for the Verification Numbers as shown, then perform the following steps: 1. Update the Tech 2(R) with the latest software from TIS2WEB. 2. Turn OFF the ignition for 90 seconds. 3. Connect the Tech 2(R) to the vehicle. 4. Turn ON the ignition, and build the vehicle. Observe the Tech 2(R) Calibration ID and Verification Number screen for proper operation. ‹› If the Tech 2(R) screen still does not display properly, then turn OFF the ignition for 90 seconds again. Turn ON the ignition and observe the same screen for proper operation. Retrieving Calibrations From a Global A Vehicle This information applies to the 2010 Camaro and is typical of the procedure that will be used on Global A vehicles. 1. Turn OFF the ignition. Page 8225 Page 4906 6. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs located on the opposite side of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover at the connector end and pry up. 7. Remove the dress cover. 8. Cut the tie wrap on the wire bundle. 9. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting a small flat-bladed tool into the small slot in the end of the slider and pushing on the TPA until it comes out of the connector. When the TPA exits the opposite side of the connector, gasp the TPA and pull it completely out of the connector. 10. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 7062 4. Slide the dress cover forward and off of the connector. 5. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front and rear of the connector. Testing and Inspection Radiator Cap: Testing and Inspection Pressure Cap Testing Tools required ^ J 24460-01 Cooling System Pressure Tester ^ J 42401 Radiator Cap / Surge Tank Test Adapter Pressure Cap Testing Caution: To avoid being burned, do not remove the radiator cap or surge tank cap while the engine is hot. The cooling system will release scalding fluid and steam under pressure if radiator cap or surge tank cap is removed while the engine and radiator are still hot. 1. Remove the pressure cap. 2. Wash the pressure cap sealing surface with water. 3. Use the J 24460-01 (1) with J 42401 (2) in order to test the pressure cap. 4. Test the pressure cap for the following conditions: ^ Pressure release when the J 24460-01 exceeds the pressure rating of the pressure cap. ^ Maintain the rated pressure for at least 10 seconds. Note the rate of pressure loss. 5. Replace the pressure cap under the following conditions: ^ The pressure cap does not release pressure which exceeds the rated pressure of the cap. ^ The pressure cap does not hold the rated pressure. Page 1135 Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Service and Repair Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure Notice: Use care when handling the coolant sensor. Damage to the coolant sensor will affect the operation of the fuel control system. 1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Raise and suitably support the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 3. Drain the cooling system below the level of the ECT sensor. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System (LL8) Draining and Filling Cooling System (LH6, LS2). 4. Lower the vehicle. 5. Disconnect the engine coolant temperature (ECT) sensor electrical connector (1). 6. Remove the ECT sensor. Installation Procedure Notice: Replacement components must be the correct part number for the application. Components requiring the use of the thread locking compound, lubricants, corrosion inhibitors, or sealants are identified in the service procedure. Some replacement components may come with these coatings already applied. Do not use these coatings on components unless specified. These coatings can affect the final torque, which may affect the operation of the component. Use the correct torque specification when installing components in order to avoid damage. Notice: Use care when handling the coolant sensor. Damage to the coolant sensor will affect the operation of the fuel control system. 1. Coat the ECT sensor threads with sealer GM P/N 12346004 (Canadian P/N 10953480), or equivalent. Page 2228 - Yazaki has a wedge or arrow shape, similar to that shown. Delphi Connectors (Micro .64) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro 64 connectors. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. The lever lock may be located on the top or sides of the wire dress cover. Page 5419 Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested: - Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. - Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a component or to other harnesses. - If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A TEST LAMP TOOLS REQUIRED J 35616-200 Test Light - Probe Kit NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminate even though voltage is present. The J 35616-200 is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair of leads. To properly operate this tool use the following procedures. When testing for voltage: 1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested. When testing for ground: 1. Attach one lead to battery positive voltage. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where ground should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is ground at the point being tested. Using Connector Test Adapters USING CONNECTOR TEST ADAPTERS NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Using Fused Jumper Wires USING FUSED JUMPER WIRES TOOLS REQUIRED J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged. The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested. AFL/ECP Connectors AFL/EPC CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 8139 5. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove TPA from the connector. 6. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Page 7410 If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs SIR/SRS WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS, and the wiring components, such as connectors and terminals. IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system terminals. Use either an SIR/SRS pigtail or a terminated lead from the SIR Repair Kit Tray. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves, in order to repair the SIR/SRS wiring - A special crimping tool - A heat torch - An instruction manual The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides the necessary low resistance contact integrity for these sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors SIR/SRS CONNECTOR REPAIR (PLASTIC BODY AND TERMINAL METAL PIN) The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made with a special plating. This plating provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. Use the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit for repairing SIR/SRS terminals and connectors. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the repair kit. The J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit contains: Various terminated leads for sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) terminal replacement - Various connector positive assurance (CPA) locks for SIR/SRS connectors - Base of steering column pigtail connectors part number 12085514 - Yellow vinyl electrical tape Pigtail repair packs are available for SIR/SRS connectors with eight or less terminals. Only the connector body is available for connectors with more than eight terminals. The terminated leads in the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit can be used to replace damaged terminals when replacing the connector body. SIR/SRS COMPONENT WIRE PIGTAIL REPAIR IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails. A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device, not by a connector. If a wiring pigtail is damaged, you must replace the entire component, with pigtail. The inflatable restraint steering wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component. SIR/SRS WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 4034 Idler Pulley: Service and Repair Drive Belt Idler Pulley Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Remove the accessory drive belt. Refer to Fastener Notice Drive Belt Replacement - Accessory. 2. Remove the drive belt idler pulley and bolt. Installation Procedure Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 1. Install the drive belt idler pulley and bolt to the generator bracket. Tighten the bolt to 50 N.m (37 lb ft). Page 5443 The first connector design of the Micro-Pack 100W (1) has a white connector interface that holds the terminals. The second design of the Micro-Pack 100W (2) has a gray interface to hold the terminals. Also, the first design has terminal cavities that are further apart (3 mm centerline) and offset from the other row of terminal cavities in the connector. The second design has terminals cavities that are closer together (2.54 mm centerline) and aligned vertically. One other way to identify the second design is the thin strip of material that runs along the outside of the cavities. IMPORTANT: There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W terminals which are very similar. Ensure that you have the correct terminal before crimping the new terminal to the wire. The first design connector uses the longer terminal (1) that has a raised area in front of the recess in the terminal. The second design connector uses the shorter terminal without the raised area. Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro-Pack 100W connectors. Some Micro-Pack 100W connector disassembly procedures will vary. Use this procedure as a guide. 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 6206 6. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs located on the opposite side of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover at the connector end and pry up. 7. Remove the dress cover. 8. Cut the tie wrap on the wire bundle. 9. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting a small flat-bladed tool into the small slot in the end of the slider and pushing on the TPA until it comes out of the connector. When the TPA exits the opposite side of the connector, gasp the TPA and pull it completely out of the connector. 10. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 360 Refer to the following table as a guide in selecting the correct test adapter for front probing connectors: Backprobe IMPORTANT: Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures. - Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector. - Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large of a test probe. - After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected, test for proper terminal contact. Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the connector. Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure SCAN TOOL SNAPSHOT PROCEDURE Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used Page 3916 under pressure if the radiator cap or the surge tank cap is removed while the engine and radiator are still hot. 4. Remove the surge tank fill cap from the surge tank or the coolant pressure cap from the radiator. 5. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle in SI. 6. Place a clean drain pan under the radiator drain cock or under the lower radiator hose depending on the vehicle. Refer to Cooling System Draining and Filling in SI. 7. Loosen the radiator drain cock if equipped or use J 38185 clamp pliers and reposition the clamp on the lower radiator hose at the radiator. 8. Remove the end of the lower radiator hose from the radiator. 9. Drain the engine coolant sufficiently below the level of the ECT sensor. 10. Close the radiator drain cock or connect the lower radiator hose at the radiator. 11. Use the J 38185 clamp pliers to place the clamp into the original position on the hose. 12. Lower the vehicle. 13. Disconnect the wiring harness connector from the ECT sensor (2). 14. Remove the ECT sensor (1) from the front of the cylinder head. 15. Remove the corresponding size plug at the rear of the OTHER cylinder head. 16. Coat the threads of the ECT sensor with sealer. Use GM P/N 12346004 (Canadian P/N 10953480) or an equivalent. 17. Install the ECT sensor in the hole of the cylinder head where the plug was removed. Tighten Tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb ft). 18. Coat the threads of the plug with sealer. Use GM P/N 12346004 (Canadian P/N 10953480) or an equivalent. 19. Install the plug in the hole of the cylinder head where the ECT sensor was removed Tighten Tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb ft). Important Leave enough wire attached to the ECT sensor harness connector in order to create manageable splices that are at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splice. Page 239 3. Use a small flat-bladed tool to gently pry off the dress cover by inserting the tool under the cover opposite the harness side and prying up. 4. Remove the cover. 5. Using a small flat-bladed tool, push on the side of the nose piece retainer while pushing the nose piece forward with your thumb. This will release the terminal position assurance (TPA). 6. Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) into the corresponding terminal release cavity. The release cavities are the 2 center rows of cavities on one half of the connector. Page 1367 8. Insert the J 38125-213 into the small terminal release hole on the nose piece and gently pull on the back of the wire. 9. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Repairing Connector Terminals REPAIRING CONNECTOR TERMINALS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following: Push to Seat terminals - Pull to Seat terminals Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your terminal repair. The J-38125 contains further information. 1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.For cable seal terminals, remove the seal. 2. Apply the correct cable seal per gage size of the wire, if used.Slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation removal. 3. Remove the insulation. 4. For sealed terminals only, align the seal with the end of the cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal.For sealed terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal. 6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.For sealed terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable. 8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals excepting Micro-Pack 100.64 size. Soldering Micro-Pack 100 World terminals may damage the terminal. Sumitomo Connectors SUMITOMO CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 1014 Steering Mounted Controls Assembly: Service and Repair Steering Wheel Control Switch Assembly Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Remove the steering wheel. 2. Remove the shroud retaining screws from the back of the steering wheel. 3. Remove the shroud from the steering wheel. 4. Position a blunt ended tool into the wire harness cavity (1) and apply moderate pressure in order to partially remove the steering wheel control switch from the steering wheel. 5. Disconnect the steering wheel control switch electrical connector. Important: The bulbs in the steering wheel control switches are not serviceable. The switches should be replaced only as an assembly. 6. Remove the steering wheel control switch from the steering wheel. Installation Procedure 1. Position the steering wheel control switch to the steering wheel. 2. Connect the electrical connector to the steering wheel control switch. 3. Install the steering wheel control switch into the steering wheel, ensuring the retaining tabs are fully seated. Page 6797 Important The M6 conductive rivet stud as shown, can accommodate a panel thickness range of 0.7-4.2 mm (0.03-0.17 in). If there are layers of sheet metal, they should be touching without any air gaps to ensure a good ground. 5. Select a M6 conductive rivet stud. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. Note Use the GE-50317 rivet stud tool kit. 6. Place the M6 conductive rivet stud (1) in the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole. Assemble the rivet stud tool (2) with the groove and flare side facing the rivet stud, then the washer and the M6 nut (3). 7. Using a wrench on the rivet stud tool, and a socket on the M6 nut, secure the M6 conductive rivet stud. 8. Ensure the rivet stud is securely fastened, WITHOUT ANY detectable movement. 9. Completely wrap the threads of the rivet stud with painters tape or equivalent. Note The rivet stud and surrounding panel area MUST BE properly refinished PRIOR to the installation of the ground wire terminal and conductive nut to maintain a secure, stable and corrosion-free electrical ground. 10. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and Repair in SI. 11. Allow the refinished repair area to cure sufficiently before removing the protective material applied to the rivet stud threads. 12. Remove the painters tape or equivalent from the rivet stud threads. 13. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, thoroughly clean the rivet stud threads to remove any adhesive and allow to dry. 14. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M6 conductive rivet stud. Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase. Page 2109 5. Insert the J 38125-557 (GM P/N 12122378) into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 6. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Connector Position Assurance Locks CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of the connector. CPAs are used in various connectors throughout the vehicle. CPAs are also used in all SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals, of the connector. Connector Repairs CONNECTOR REPAIRS Page 1775 View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. 4. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers CIRCUIT PROTECTION - CIRCUIT BREAKERS A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types of circuit Page 7210 7. The illustration above identifies the entry canal where the terminal release tool will be inserted, and the terminal cavity. - Terminal (1) - Entry Canal (2) 8. Insert the J-38125-553 (15315247) tool into the entry canal and pry up on the terminal retainer. The terminal retainer is a small plastic piece on the top of the terminal. The terminal retainer must be held up while the terminal is pulled out of the connector. Page 6912 TERMINAL REMOVAL Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors. 1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA) device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1). 3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 4. Gently pull the cable and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector. 5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal, refer to Terminal Repair. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3. Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector. REINSTALLING TERMINAL 1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly, refer to Wiring Repairs. 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3. Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) DELPHI CONNECTORS (WEATHER PACK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 1898 5. Once the nose piece retainers are relaxed, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should raise slightly. 6. On the opposite side of the nose piece, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should release completely. If the nose piece does not come off, repeat the procedure on the opposite side. Diagrams Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch: Diagrams HVAC Connector End Views Air Temperature Sensor Assembly - Inside Page 4943 8. Insert the J 38125-213 into the small terminal release hole on the nose piece and gently pull on the back of the wire. 9. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Repairing Connector Terminals REPAIRING CONNECTOR TERMINALS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following: Push to Seat terminals - Pull to Seat terminals Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your terminal repair. The J-38125 contains further information. 1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.For cable seal terminals, remove the seal. 2. Apply the correct cable seal per gage size of the wire, if used.Slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation removal. 3. Remove the insulation. 4. For sealed terminals only, align the seal with the end of the cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal.For sealed terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal. 6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.For sealed terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable. 8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals excepting Micro-Pack 100.64 size. Soldering Micro-Pack 100 World terminals may damage the terminal. Sumitomo Connectors SUMITOMO CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 4602 5. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove TPA from the connector. 6. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE A/T - Key Will Not Release From Ignition Lock Cylinder Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Customer Interest A/T - Key Will Not Release From Ignition Lock Cylinder Bulletin No.: 05-07-30-021B Date: October 04, 2007 TECHNICAL Subject: Ignition Key Will Not Remove From Ignition Lock Cylinder (Reposition Shifter Boot) Models: 2004-2007 Buick Rainier 2002-2008 Chevrolet TrailBlazer Models 2002-2008 GMC Envoy Models 2003-2004 Oldsmobile Bravada Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to include the 2008 model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 05-07-30-021A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle). Condition Some customers may comment that they are unable to remove the ignition key from the ignition cylinder. Cause The shifter boot may be caught/trapped in the shifter assembly mechanism. Correction Inspect the shifter boot for being caught/trapped in the shifter assembly. If the shifter boot is NOT caught/trapped in the shift assembly, refer to Ignition Key Cannot Be Removed from the Ignition Lock Cylinder in SI. If the shifter boot IS caught/trapped in the shifter assembly, continue with the next step. DO NOT replace the complete shifter assembly for this condition. ONLY replace the shifter boot/handle if damaged by shifter assembly. Reposition the shifter boot so that it is not caught/trapped in the shifter assembly. Warranty Information Drivetrain - Updated Transfer Case Speed Sensor Conn. Speed Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Drivetrain - Updated Transfer Case Speed Sensor Conn. Bulletin No.: 06-04-21-001 Date: May 17, 2006 INFORMATION Subject: Updated Transfer Case Connector Service Kit Now Available For Transfer Case Speed Sensor Wire Harness Connector that Comes Loose Or Connector Retainer Clip Breaks Models: 2007 and Prior GM Light Duty Trucks 2007 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X with Four-Wheel Drive or All-Wheel Drive Technicians may find that when the transfer case speed sensor wire harness connector is removed, the connector lock flexes/bends and does not return to the original position. The transfer case speed sensor wire harness connector then has no locking device. On older vehicles, the plastic connector retainer becomes brittle and the clip may break as soon as it is flexed. In the past, the only service fix was to install a wire harness connector service pack, P/N 88987183. This repair procedure involved splicing a new service connector with an integral connector lock. This connector service kit is of the same design and was still prone to failure over time. A new connector service repair kit is now available, P/N 15306187, that is an updated design. This new kit should be used whenever the speed sensor wire harness connector requires replacement. Parts Information Disclaimer Page 5559 7. Apply pressure and gently rock the cover until one locking leg is unseated. 8. Continue to apply pressure and rock the cover until the second locking leg is unseated. Repeat procedure for the other side of the dress cover and remove the cover. 9. Use J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) to gently lift the terminal retaining tab while gently pulling the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 10. If the terminal is severely bent or damaged, it may be possible on some connectors to push the wire out of the front of the connector instead of Page 507 Release the lower wiredress cover locking tab. Release the upper wiredress cover locking tab. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. Page 5463 MOLEX CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. 2. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. Page 6261 2. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully push the terminal position assurance (TPA) towards the face of the connector on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA is fragile and may break if not done carefully. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. 3. Use the J 38125-215 tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 2266 4. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the rear of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. 5. Once the locking tabs are unlocked, slide the inner connector out of the rear of the connector housing. Page 2408 Important: Before installing the camshaft sensor assembly, apply a small amount of clean motor oil to the O-ring (6). 4. Install the camshaft position sensor assembly (4, 5, 6) in the front cover (7). Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 5. Install the camshaft position sensor mounting bolts. Tighten the camshaft position mounting bolts 25 N.m (18 lb ft). 6. Install the generator assembly. Page 7192 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the TPA. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the nose piece. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. Page 8895 Refer to the following table as a guide in selecting the correct test adapter for front probing connectors: Backprobe IMPORTANT: Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures. - Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector. - Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large of a test probe. - After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected, test for proper terminal contact. Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the connector. Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure SCAN TOOL SNAPSHOT PROCEDURE Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used Page 4404 TERMINAL REMOVAL Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors. 1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA) device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1). 3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 4. Gently pull the cable and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector. 5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal, refer to Terminal Repair. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3. Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector. REINSTALLING TERMINAL 1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly, refer to Wiring Repairs. 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3. Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) DELPHI CONNECTORS (WEATHER PACK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 4636 4. Slide the dress cover forward and off of the connector. 5. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front and rear of the connector. Page 527 9. The illustration shows a cutaway view of the connector to aid the technician in releasing the terminal retainer. 10. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Terminal Position Assurance Locks TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Tyco/Amp Connectors (CM 42-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (CM 42-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the connector body and pull the CPA out. The CPA is on the wire harness side of connector. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 742 3. Use a small flat-bladed tool to gently pry off the dress cover by inserting the tool under the cover opposite the harness side and prying up. 4. Remove the cover. 5. Using a small flat-bladed tool, push on the side of the nose piece retainer while pushing the nose piece forward with your thumb. This will release the terminal position assurance (TPA). 6. Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) into the corresponding terminal release cavity. The release cavities are the 2 center rows of cavities on one half of the connector. Page 1676 Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Remove the fuel tank. 2. Disconnect the fuel tank pressure sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove the fuel tank pressure sensor. Installation Procedure 1. Install the fuel tank pressure sensor. 2. Connect the fuel tank pressure sensor electrical connector. 3. Install the fuel tank. Page 4613 View of a typical Micro 64 connector. Depress the lock and pull the lever over and past the lock. Page 8432 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 7894 results from the alteration or modification of a vehicle using non-GM approved parts or accessories. Dealers should be especially cautious of accessory companies that claim the installation of their product will not void the factory warranty. Many times these companies have even given direction on how to quickly disassemble the accessory in an attempt to preclude the manufacturer from finding out that is has been installed. Any suspect repairs should be reviewed by the Fixed Operations Manager (FOM), and in Canada by the Warranty Manager (WM) for appropriate repair direction. If it is decided that a goodwill repair is to be made on the vehicle, even with the installation of such non-GM approved components, the customer is to be made aware of General Motors position on this issue and is to sign the appropriate goodwill documentation required by General Motors. It is imperative for dealers to understand that by installing such devices, they are jeopardizing not only the warranty coverage, but also the performance and reliability of the customer's vehicle. Disclaimer Page 2668 Electronic Frontal Sensor (EFS) - Right Inflatable Restraint Passenger Presence System (PPS) Sensor Page 3279 4. Use a small flat-blade tool to slide the terminal position assurance (TPA) up one notch on both ends of the connector. The TPA is located underneath the wire dress cover. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 427 View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. View of the release tool being used for the smaller terminals. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (2-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 7686 11. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 12. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 13. Center the high temperature SCT1 shrink tube over the DuraSeal splice sleeve. 14. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the high temperature heat shrink tubing. 15. Gradually move the heat from the center to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 16. Replace any reflective tape and clips that may have been remove during the repair. Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation REPAIRING DAMAGED WIRE INSULATION Wire Size Conversion Page 4373 It is very important to use the correct test adapter when testing for proper terminal contact of fuses and relays in a bussed electrical center (BEC). Use J-35616-35 to test for proper terminal contact. Failure to use J-35616-35 can result in improper diagnosis of the BEC. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Separate the connector halves. 2. Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body. 3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J-38125 , test that the retention force is significantly different between a good terminal and a suspect terminal. Replace the female terminal in question. FLAT WIRE (DOCK AND LOCK) CONNECTORS There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock) connectors on the harness side or the component side. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Remove the component in question. 2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side of the connector as oil from your skin may be a source of contamination as well. 3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other imperfections that could cause poor terminal contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are uniform and free of damage or deformation. 4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the on the flat wire harness connector in order to test the circuit in question. CONTROL MODULE/COMPONENT VOLTAGE AND GROUNDS Poor voltage or ground connections can cause widely varying symptoms. Test all control module voltage supply circuits. Many vehicles have multiple circuits supplying voltage to a control module. Other components in the system may have separate voltage supply circuits that may also need to be tested. Inspect connections at the module/component connectors, fuses, and any intermediate connections between the voltage source and the module/component. A test lamp or a DMM may indicate that voltage is present, but neither tests the ability of the circuit to carry sufficient current. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Power Distribution Schematics. - Test all control module ground and system ground circuits. The control module may have multiple ground circuits. Other components in the system may have separate grounds that may also need to be tested. Inspect grounds for clean and tight connections at the grounding point. Inspect the connections at the component and in splice packs, where applicable. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Ground Distribution Schematics. TEMPERATURE SENSITIVITY - An intermittent condition may occur when a component/connection reaches normal operating temperature. The condition may occur only when the component/connection is cold, or only when the component/connection is hot. - Freeze Frame, Failure Records, Snapshot, or Vehicle Data Recorder data may help with this type of intermittent condition, where applicable. - If the intermittent is related to heat, review the data for a relationship with the following: High ambient temperatures - Underhood/engine generated heat - Circuit generated heat due to a poor connection, or high electrical load - Higher than normal load conditions, towing, etc. - If the intermittent is related to cold, review the data for the following: Low ambient temperatures-In extremely low temperatures, ice may form in a connection or component. Inspect for water intrusion. - The condition only occurs on a cold start. - The condition goes away when the vehicle warms up. - Information from the customer may help to determine if the trouble follows a pattern that is temperature related. - If temperature is suspected of causing an intermittent fault condition, attempt to duplicate the condition. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required. ELECTROMAGNETIC INTERFERENCE (EMI) AND ELECTRICAL NOISE Some electrical components/circuits are sensitive to electromagnetic interference (EMI) or other types of electrical noise. Inspect for the following conditions: A misrouted harness that is too close to high voltage/high current devices such as secondary ignition components, motors, generator etc-These components may induce electrical noise on a circuit that could interfere with normal circuit operation. - Electrical system interference caused by a malfunctioning relay, or a control module driven solenoid or switch-These conditions can cause a sharp electrical surge. Normally, the condition will occur when the malfunctioning component is operating. - Improper installation of non-factory or aftermarket add on accessories such as lights, 2-way radios, amplifiers, electric motors, remote starters, alarm systems, cell phones, etc-These accessories may lead to interference while in use, but do not fail when the accessories are not in use. - Test for an open diode across the A/C compressor clutch and for other open diodes. Some relays may contain a clamping diode. - The generator may be allowing AC noise into the electrical system. INCORRECT CONTROL MODULE - There are only a few situations where reprogramming a control module is appropriate: A new service control module is installed. Page 4645 7. The illustration above identifies the entry canal where the terminal release tool will be inserted, and the terminal cavity. - Terminal (1) - Entry Canal (2) 8. Insert the J-38125-553 (15315247) tool into the entry canal and pry up on the terminal retainer. The terminal retainer is a small plastic piece on the top of the terminal. The terminal retainer must be held up while the terminal is pulled out of the connector. Page 3347 All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system. Page 8327 US English/Metric Conversion US English/Metric Conversion Page 5020 Water Pump: Service and Repair WATER PUMP REPLACEMENT Tools Required J 38185 Hose Clamp Pliers Removal Procedure 1. Drain the cooling system. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System (LL8) Draining and Filling Cooling System (LH6, LS2). 2. Loosen the air cleaner outlet duct clamps at the following locations: ^ Throttle body ^ Mass air flow (MAF)/intake air temperature (IAT) sensor 3. Remove the air cleaner outlet duct bolt and duct. 4. Remove the accessory drive belt tensioner. Refer to Drive Belt Tensioner Replacement - Accessory for the 5.3L engine or Drive Belt Tensioner Replacement - Accessory for the 6.0L engine. 5. Remove the cooing fan and shroud. Refer to Cooling Fan and Shroud Replacement. 6. Using the J 38185, reposition the inlet hose clamp at the water pump. Page 2440 difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Bosch Connectors (ECM) BOSCH CONNECTORS (ECM) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the assist lever on the top of the connector. Move the assist lever to the forward position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 945 Page 8112 Page 6484 6. Gently pry the plastic terminal retainer down and carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (16-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, pull the two connector halves apart. Page 2523 Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Crankshaft Position System Variation Learn Crankshaft Position System Variation Learn 1. Install a scan tool. 2. Monitor the engine control module (ECM) for DTCs with a scan tool. If other DTCs are set, except DTC P0315, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle in Vehicle DTC Information for the applicable DTC that set. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Descriptions 3. Select the crankshaft position (CKP) variation learn procedure with a scan tool. 4. The scan tool instructs you to perform the following: 1. Accelerate to wide open throttle (WOT). 2. Release throttle when fuel cut-off occurs. 3. Observe fuel cut-off for applicable engine. 4. Engine should not accelerate beyond calibrated RPM value. 5. Release throttle immediately if value is exceeded. 6. Block drive wheels. 7. Set parking brake. 8. DO NOT apply brake pedal. 9. Cycle ignition from OFF to ON. 10. Apply and hold brake pedal. 11. Start and idle engine. 12. Turn A/C OFF. 13. Vehicle must remain in Park or Neutral. 14. The scan tool monitors certain component signals to determine if all the conditions are met to continue with the procedure. The scan tool only displays the condition that inhibits the procedure. The scan tool monitors the following components: * CKP sensors activity-If there is a CKP sensor condition, refer to the applicable DTC that set. * Camshaft position (CMP) sensor activity-If there is a CMP sensor condition, refer to the applicable DTC that set. * Engine coolant temperature (ECT)-If the ECT is not warm enough, idle the engine until the engine coolant temperature reaches the correct temperature. 5. Enable the CKP system variation learn procedure with a scan tool. Important: While the learn procedure is in progress, release the throttle immediately when the engine starts to decelerate. The engine control is returned to the operator and the engine responds to throttle position after the learn procedure is complete. 6. Accelerate to WOT. 7. Release when the fuel cut-off occurs. 8. Test in progress 9. The scan tool displays Learn Status: Learned this ignition. If the scan tool indicates that DTC P0315 ran and passed, the CKP variation learn procedure is complete. If the scan tool indicates DTC P0315 failed or did not run, refer to DTC P0315. If any other DTCs set, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle in Vehicle DTC Information for the applicable DTC that set. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Descriptions See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/P Code Charts/P0315 10. Turn OFF the ignition for 30 seconds after the learn procedure is completed successfully. 11. The CKP system variation learn procedure is also required when the following service procedures have been performed, regardless of whether DTC P0315 is set: * A CKP sensor replacement * An engine replacement * A ECM replacement * A harmonic balancer replacement * A crankshaft replacement * Any engine repairs which disturb the CKP sensor relationship Page 7204 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. 4. Remove the dress cover by using a flat bladed tool to release the dress cover locking tabs and lift up on the dress cover. 5. Cut the tie wrap that holds the wires to the connector body. Fuel Level Sensor Replacement Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair Fuel Level Sensor Replacement Fuel Level Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Remove the fuel sender assembly. 2. Disconnect the fuel level sensor electrical connector (1). 3. Depress the fuel level sensor retaining tabs (2) to release the sensor from the sender assembly. 4. Remove the fuel level sensor electrical connector (1) and sensor (2) from the fuel sender assembly. Installation Procedure Page 6694 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Ensure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the Terminal Removal Procedure. Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PULL TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL If the terminal is visibly damaged or is suspected of having a faulty connection, the terminal should be replaced. Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors: 1. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) device and/or the secondary lock. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component or separate the connectors for in-line connectors. 3. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device. 4. Insert the proper pick or removal tool into the front of the connector body. 5. IMPORTANT: On connectors with more than one terminal the service loop may not be large enough to remove the terminal and crimp on a new one. If the terminal wire does not have a large enough service loop for removal, cut the wire 5 cm (2 in) behind the connector before removal. Grasp the wire at the back of the connector body and gently push the terminal out the front of the connector body. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. If the wire needed to be cut in order to remove the terminal, gently push a small length of the same size wire through the back of the connector cavity until there is enough wire exposed in order to crimp on a new terminal. If the wire was not cut, cut the existing wire as close to the old terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 4. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. TERMINAL INSTALLATION 1. Align the terminal and pull the wire from the back of the connector in order to seat the terminal. 2. If necessary, cut the new wire to proper length and splice with existing circuit. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. 3. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply dielectric grease to the connector. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PUSH TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Locations Crankshaft Position Sensor: Locations Engine Controls Component Views Lower Right Side of the Engine - Rear 1 - Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor 2 - Knock Sensor (KS) 2 - Right 3 - Engine Harness 4 Starter 5 - Engine Page 8117 Utility/Van Zoning UTILITY/VAN ZONING Fuel Pressure Relief Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair Fuel Pressure Relief Fuel Pressure Relief Tools Required CH-48027 Digital Pressure Gage With CH-48027 Caution: Refer to Gasoline/Gasoline Vapors Caution. Caution: Remove the fuel tank cap and relieve the fuel system pressure before servicing the fuel system in order to reduce the risk of personal injury. After you relieve the fuel system pressure, a small amount of fuel may be released when servicing the fuel lines, the fuel injection pump, or the connections. In order to reduce the risk of personal injury, cover the fuel system components with a shop towel before disconnection. This will catch any fuel that may leak out. Place the towel in an approved container when the disconnection is complete. 1. Remove the engine cover, if required. 2. Loosen the fuel fill cap in order to relieve the fuel tank vapor pressure. 3. Remove the fuel rail service port cap. Caution: Wrap a shop towel around the fuel pressure connection in order to reduce the risk of fire and personal injury. The towel will absorb any fuel leakage that occurs during the connection of the fuel pressure gage. Place the towel in an approved container when the connection of the fuel pressure gage is complete. 4. Wrap a shop towel around the fuel rail service port. 5. Connect the CH-48027-3 (4) to the fuel rail service port. 6. Connect the CH-48027-2 (2) to the CH-48027-3 (4). 7. Place the hose on the CH-48027-2 (2) into an approved gasoline container. 8. Open the valve on the CH-48027-2 (2) in order to bleed any fuel from the fuel rail. 9. Close the valve on the CH-48027-2 (2). 10. Remove the hose on the CH-48027-2 (2) from the approved gasoline container. Important: If relieving the fuel pressure for the fuel pressure gage installation and removal, it is NOT necessary to proceed with the following steps. Notice: Clean all of the following areas before performing any disconnections in order to avoid possible contamination in the system: * The fuel pipe connections Page 1607 Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. FCI Connectors FCI CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 5665 MEASURING FREQUENCY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal. IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM to autorange to an appropriate range. 1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency measured. Measuring Voltage MEASURING VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit. 1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods: - Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. - Turn ON the engine. - Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls. - Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested. 3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The DMM displays the voltage measured at that point. Measuring Voltage Drop MEASURING VOLTAGE DROP NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points. Probing Electrical Connectors PROBING ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS Page 9073 3. Ensure that the terminal release tang access panel is in the correct location to access the terminals. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) into the terminal release tang access slot located behind the access panel of the connector and press down on the terminal while carefully pulling the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Tyco/AMP Connectors (0.25 Cap) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (025 CAP) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component by pressing down on the connector position assurance (CPA). Page 2590 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert terminal into the appropriate terminal holder until it hits bottom and stops. The correct terminal holder is determined by the wire size. Also ensure that the terminals wings are pointing towards the former on the tool and the release locator. 5. Insert the stripped cable into the terminal. Insulation should be visible on both sides of the terminal insulation wings. 6. Compress the handles until the ratchet automatically releases. 7. Place the terminal into the appropriate cavity and assemble the connector. Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO-PACK 100W) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W connectors. These connectors are very similar but use different terminals and have some minor physical differences also. Page 8783 It is very important to use the correct test adapter when testing for proper terminal contact of fuses and relays in a bussed electrical center (BEC). Use J-35616-35 to test for proper terminal contact. Failure to use J-35616-35 can result in improper diagnosis of the BEC. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Separate the connector halves. 2. Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body. 3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J-38125 , test that the retention force is significantly different between a good terminal and a suspect terminal. Replace the female terminal in question. FLAT WIRE (DOCK AND LOCK) CONNECTORS There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock) connectors on the harness side or the component side. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Remove the component in question. 2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side of the connector as oil from your skin may be a source of contamination as well. 3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other imperfections that could cause poor terminal contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are uniform and free of damage or deformation. 4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the on the flat wire harness connector in order to test the circuit in question. CONTROL MODULE/COMPONENT VOLTAGE AND GROUNDS Poor voltage or ground connections can cause widely varying symptoms. Test all control module voltage supply circuits. Many vehicles have multiple circuits supplying voltage to a control module. Other components in the system may have separate voltage supply circuits that may also need to be tested. Inspect connections at the module/component connectors, fuses, and any intermediate connections between the voltage source and the module/component. A test lamp or a DMM may indicate that voltage is present, but neither tests the ability of the circuit to carry sufficient current. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Power Distribution Schematics. - Test all control module ground and system ground circuits. The control module may have multiple ground circuits. Other components in the system may have separate grounds that may also need to be tested. Inspect grounds for clean and tight connections at the grounding point. Inspect the connections at the component and in splice packs, where applicable. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Ground Distribution Schematics. TEMPERATURE SENSITIVITY - An intermittent condition may occur when a component/connection reaches normal operating temperature. The condition may occur only when the component/connection is cold, or only when the component/connection is hot. - Freeze Frame, Failure Records, Snapshot, or Vehicle Data Recorder data may help with this type of intermittent condition, where applicable. - If the intermittent is related to heat, review the data for a relationship with the following: High ambient temperatures - Underhood/engine generated heat - Circuit generated heat due to a poor connection, or high electrical load - Higher than normal load conditions, towing, etc. - If the intermittent is related to cold, review the data for the following: Low ambient temperatures-In extremely low temperatures, ice may form in a connection or component. Inspect for water intrusion. - The condition only occurs on a cold start. - The condition goes away when the vehicle warms up. - Information from the customer may help to determine if the trouble follows a pattern that is temperature related. - If temperature is suspected of causing an intermittent fault condition, attempt to duplicate the condition. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required. ELECTROMAGNETIC INTERFERENCE (EMI) AND ELECTRICAL NOISE Some electrical components/circuits are sensitive to electromagnetic interference (EMI) or other types of electrical noise. Inspect for the following conditions: A misrouted harness that is too close to high voltage/high current devices such as secondary ignition components, motors, generator etc-These components may induce electrical noise on a circuit that could interfere with normal circuit operation. - Electrical system interference caused by a malfunctioning relay, or a control module driven solenoid or switch-These conditions can cause a sharp electrical surge. Normally, the condition will occur when the malfunctioning component is operating. - Improper installation of non-factory or aftermarket add on accessories such as lights, 2-way radios, amplifiers, electric motors, remote starters, alarm systems, cell phones, etc-These accessories may lead to interference while in use, but do not fail when the accessories are not in use. - Test for an open diode across the A/C compressor clutch and for other open diodes. Some relays may contain a clamping diode. - The generator may be allowing AC noise into the electrical system. INCORRECT CONTROL MODULE - There are only a few situations where reprogramming a control module is appropriate: A new service control module is installed. Page 8674 - In some cases Delphi will actually be printed on the connector. If Delphi is not printed on the connector, look for PED. In both cases there is no specific orientation for Delphi or PED and they can appear anywhere on the connector. - FCI connectors may have the FCI logo on their connectors. The logo is the letters FCI with an "A" above it. - JAE connector have JAE in small letters on their connectors. Page 2341 View of the connector when released from the component. View of another type of Micro 64 connector. Page 54 Disclaimer Page 7071 7. The illustration above identifies the entry canal where the terminal release tool will be inserted, and the terminal cavity. - Terminal (1) - Entry Canal (2) 8. Insert the J-38125-553 (15315247) tool into the entry canal and pry up on the terminal retainer. The terminal retainer is a small plastic piece on the top of the terminal. The terminal retainer must be held up while the terminal is pulled out of the connector. Page 2141 MOLEX CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. 2. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. Page 8019 7. Apply pressure and gently rock the cover until one locking leg is unseated. 8. Continue to apply pressure and rock the cover until the second locking leg is unseated. Repeat procedure for the other side of the dress cover and remove the cover. 9. Use J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) to gently lift the terminal retaining tab while gently pulling the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 10. If the terminal is severely bent or damaged, it may be possible on some connectors to push the wire out of the front of the connector instead of Page 1501 breakers are used. CIRCUIT BREAKER This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high current is removed. POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) CIRCUIT BREAKER This type greatly increases its resistance when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker will re-close within a second or 2. Circuit Protection - Fuses CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSES The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and examine the element in the fuse for an open (2). If not broken (1), also check for continuity using a DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one of equal current rating. Circuit Protection - Fusible Links CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSIBLE LINKS Page 2588 Depress the locks that are located on both sides of the wiredress cover and pull the lever over and past the locks. View of the connector when released from the component. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the front of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool push down on one of the locking tabs and pull the cover up until the dress cover releases. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. Service and Repair Air Cleaner Fresh Air Duct/Hose: Service and Repair Air Cleaner Resonator Outlet Duct Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Disconnect the positive crankcase ventilation (PCV) fresh air tube (2) from the air cleaner resonator outlet duct (1). 2. Loosen the clamps at the following: * Mass air flow (MAF)/intake air temperature (IAT) sensor * Throttle body 3. Remove the air cleaner outlet duct bolt. 4. Remove the air cleaner outlet duct. Installation Procedure Page 3325 US English/Metric Conversion US English/Metric Conversion Page 8367 Page 7154 Refer to the following table as a guide in selecting the correct test adapter for front probing connectors: Backprobe IMPORTANT: Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures. - Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector. - Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large of a test probe. - After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected, test for proper terminal contact. Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the connector. Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure SCAN TOOL SNAPSHOT PROCEDURE Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used Page 6217 Depress the locks that are located on both sides of the wiredress cover and pull the lever over and past the locks. View of the connector when released from the component. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the front of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool push down on one of the locking tabs and pull the cover up until the dress cover releases. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. Page 6110 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. JST Connectors JST CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, remove the connector from the component. Page 8305 5. While pushing the terminal forward, insert the J 38125-24 in the release cavity above the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (43-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Locations Seat Heater Switch: Locations Front Passenger Door Module (FPDM) Page 8579 2. Use a small flat-bladed tool to release the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting the tool in the small recess on the side of the connector and pushing up until the TPA releases from the connector body. The TPA should raise just slightly. Do not try to remove the TPA. IMPORTANT: The TPA on this connector cannot be removed unless the terminals are removed first. The TPA will come out of the connector body, but only slightly. When the TPA is slightly raised the terminals can be removed. Using excessive force to remove the TPA with the terminals still in the connector will damage the connector. 3. Repeat the process for the other side of the connector. 4. Ensure that the TPA is in the proper position to remove the terminals. Page 5477 3. Ensure that the terminal release tang access panel is in the correct location to access the terminals. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) into the terminal release tang access slot located behind the access panel of the connector and press down on the terminal while carefully pulling the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Tyco/AMP Connectors (0.25 Cap) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (025 CAP) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component by pressing down on the connector position assurance (CPA). Page 5703 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) and slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. Page 5574 View of typical connector. View of connector in released position. 1. Locate the assist lever at the back of the connector. Move the assist lever to the rear position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the dress cover. Page 3370 6. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs located on the opposite side of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover at the connector end and pry up. 7. Remove the dress cover. 8. Cut the tie wrap on the wire bundle. 9. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting a small flat-bladed tool into the small slot in the end of the slider and pushing on the TPA until it comes out of the connector. When the TPA exits the opposite side of the connector, gasp the TPA and pull it completely out of the connector. 10. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 8770 Page 6570 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. JST Connectors JST CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, remove the connector from the component. Page 2313 vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide variety of actions, including: - Wiggling the harness - Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting - Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector - Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation - Relocating a harness or wires All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. Another option is, with the component commanded ON and OFF by the scan tool, move related connectors and wiring and observe the component operation. With the engine running, move related connectors and wiring while monitoring engine operation. If harness or connector movement affects the data displayed, component/system operation, or engine operation, inspect and repair the harness/connections as necessary. You may need to load the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these cases you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide good results as well. There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions, along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the circuit to these kinds of conditions. SALT WATER SPRAY Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture. Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5 percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously. HIGH TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070. Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault condition. The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis. This option does not allow for the same control, however. LOW TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect. If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to -18°C (0°F) from one end and +71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized cooling needs. Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or components in an effort to duplicate the concern. DUPLICATING FAILURE CONDITIONS - If none of the previous tests are successful, attempt to duplicate and/or capture the failure conditions. Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, where applicable, contains the conditions that were present when the DTC set. 1. Review and record Freeze Frame/Failure Records data. 2. Clear the DTCs using the scan tool. 3. Turn the key to OFF and wait 15 seconds. 4. Operate the vehicle under the same conditions that were noted in Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, as closely as possible. The vehicle must also be operating within the Conditions for Running the DTC. Refer to Conditions for Running the DTC in the supporting text if a DTC is being diagnosed. 5. Monitor DTC Status for the DTC being tested. The scan tool will indicate Ran, when the enabling conditions have been satisfied long enough for the DTC to run. The scan tool will also indicate whether the DTC passed or failed. - An alternate method is to drive the vehicle with the DMM connected to a suspected circuit. An abnormal reading on the DMM when the concern occurs, may help you locate the concern. Measuring Frequency Page 4403 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Ensure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the Terminal Removal Procedure. Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PULL TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL If the terminal is visibly damaged or is suspected of having a faulty connection, the terminal should be replaced. Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors: 1. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) device and/or the secondary lock. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component or separate the connectors for in-line connectors. 3. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device. 4. Insert the proper pick or removal tool into the front of the connector body. 5. IMPORTANT: On connectors with more than one terminal the service loop may not be large enough to remove the terminal and crimp on a new one. If the terminal wire does not have a large enough service loop for removal, cut the wire 5 cm (2 in) behind the connector before removal. Grasp the wire at the back of the connector body and gently push the terminal out the front of the connector body. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. If the wire needed to be cut in order to remove the terminal, gently push a small length of the same size wire through the back of the connector cavity until there is enough wire exposed in order to crimp on a new terminal. If the wire was not cut, cut the existing wire as close to the old terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 4. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. TERMINAL INSTALLATION 1. Align the terminal and pull the wire from the back of the connector in order to seat the terminal. 2. If necessary, cut the new wire to proper length and splice with existing circuit. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. 3. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply dielectric grease to the connector. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PUSH TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 6663 If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200 DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J 39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected. IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J 39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and maximum (MAX) values measured. 1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of a suspected circuit to the other. 2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J 39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep). IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value in order to record the full change. 5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling the connections or the wiring, test driving, or performing other operations. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions. 6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9. Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist. Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections TESTING FOR INTERMITTENT CONDITIONS AND POOR CONNECTIONS TOOLS REQUIRED - J 35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit - J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit When the condition is not currently present, but is indicated in DTC history, the cause may be intermittent. An intermittent may also be the cause when there is a customer complaint, but the symptom cannot be duplicated. Refer to the Symptom Table of the system that is suspect of causing the condition before trying to locate an intermittent condition. Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the following items: Wiring broken inside the insulation - Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector - Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself, and corrosion in the wire to terminal contact area, etc. - Pierced or damaged insulation can allow moisture to enter the wiring causing corrosion. The conductor can corrode inside the insulation, with little visible evidence. Look for swollen and stiff sections of wire in the suspect circuits. - Wiring which has been pinched, cut, or its insulation rubbed through may cause an intermittent open or short as the bare area touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle. - Wiring that comes in contact with hot or exhaust components - Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required, in order to verify the customer concern. - Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. - Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis and Vehicle Data Recorder operation. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any inline connectors before replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation. Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination, usually in the underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit. Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper adapter. Always use the J 35616 when probing connectors. Other causes of terminal deformation are improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT IN BUSSED ELECTRICAL CENTERS (BEC) Page 5177 - Most Molex connectors will have the Molex logo on the dresscover of the connector. In some cases the connectors may have MX followed by another letter. The third letter indicates where the connector was made. A connector with MXD is a Molex connector made in Detroit. Sumitomo has a unique symbol on their connector and possibly a part number. The symbol is similar to that of a diamond lying on its side, similar to that shown. The logo could appear anywhere but the most common place is at the wire side of the housing. Tyco/AMP has many different and unique connector designs. Some may or may not have identifiable marks on them. Page 2276 View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. 4. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers CIRCUIT PROTECTION - CIRCUIT BREAKERS A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types of circuit Page 8541 Depress the locks that are located on both sides of the wiredress cover and pull the lever over and past the locks. View of the connector when released from the component. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the front of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool push down on one of the locking tabs and pull the cover up until the dress cover releases. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. Page 4408 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the TPA. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the nose piece. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. Page 4830 MOLEX CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. 2. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. Page 3790 2. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully push the terminal position assurance (TPA) towards the face of the connector on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA is fragile and may break if not done carefully. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. 3. Use the J 38125-215 tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 7999 difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Bosch Connectors (ECM) BOSCH CONNECTORS (ECM) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the assist lever on the top of the connector. Move the assist lever to the forward position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 7412 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the DuraSeal splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of a connector. CPAs are used in all SIR System connectors and also in some connectors of other systems. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals of a connection. TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE CLIPS IMPORTANT: When making a splice in an area that may be exposed to moisture use a crimp and seal splice sleeve instead of a Splice Clip. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. Knock Sensor Replacement (Left Side) Knock Sensor: Service and Repair Knock Sensor Replacement (Left Side) Knock Sensor Replacement (Left Side) Removal Procedure 1. Remove the mounting bolt for the knock sensor 1. 2. Disconnect the electrical connector of the knock sensor from the engine harness (3). 3. Remove the knock sensor (2) from the engine block (4). Installation Procedure 1. Reconnect the engine harness (3) and the knock sensor (2) electrical connectors. 2. Position the knock sensor 2 on the engine block (4). 3. Install the mounting bolt (1) for the knock sensor 2. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 4. Tighten the knock sensor mounting bolt (1). Tighten the knock sensor mounting bolt to 20 N.m (15 lb ft). Page 6154 5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape. Seat Belt Schematic Icons Seat Belt Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons Restraints - Air Bag Lamp ON/DTC B0092 Set Air Bag Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Restraints - Air Bag Lamp ON/DTC B0092 Set Bulletin No.: 07-09-41-005 Date: July 10, 2007 TECHNICAL Subject: Airbag Light On, Passenger Airbag Status Indicator Reads Off, DTC B0092 Set (Diagnose and Replace SDM, if Necessary) Models: 2007 Chevrolet TrailBlazer 2007 GMC Envoy 2007 HUMMER H3 without Roof Side Inflatable Restraint (RPO ASF) Condition Some customers may comment that the airbag light is illuminated and the passenger airbag status indicator reads off even though a occupant is in the seat. Upon investigation, the technician may find communication error DTC B0092 set in the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM). Correction Using the Tech 2(R), request module ID information to determine the part number of the SDM. If the SDM part number is 25833651 (Envoy/TrailBlazer) or 25833286 (H3), replace the SDM before proceeding with DTC B0092 diagnosis. If the part number of the SDM is other than those listed above, follow diagnostic instructions published in SI. Parts Information Warranty Information Cooling System - Inspecting Radiator/Heater Hose Clamps Coolant Line/Hose: Technical Service Bulletins Cooling System - Inspecting Radiator/Heater Hose Clamps INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 06-06-02-014B Date: June 13, 2008 Subject: Inspecting Radiator and Heater Hose Clamps and Seals for Leaks During Pre-Delivery Inspection (PDI) Models: 2007 Buick Rainier 2007-2009 Chevrolet TrailBlazer, TrailBlazer SS 2007-2009 GMC Envoy 2007-2009 Saab 9-7X Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2009 model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 06-06-02-014A (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). The purpose of this bulletin is to inform dealers of required inspection of underhood and under vehicle radiator and heater hose clamps and seals for leaks and/or seepage during pre-delivery inspection (PDI). Field feedback indicates that some customers may notice engine coolant leaks shortly after delivery, which may result in an immediate decline of customer satisfaction with their new vehicle purchase. When performing a PDI on a vehicle listed in the models affected above, pay specific attention to the effectiveness of the engine coolant hose seal locations. Reposition/reclamp or replace the clamp to effect a proper system seal prior to customer delivery. Locations to Inspect During PDI Dealership personnel should examine the following locations closely during PDI (4.2L LL8 application shown in graphics below; refer to SI for specific information on 5.3L LH6 and 6.0L LS2):L LH6 and 6.0L LS2): 1. Radiator inlet hose (upper hose) to radiator (1). 2. Radiator inlet hose (upper hose) to engine (2). Page 3658 Wheels: Service and Repair Aluminum Wheel Refinishing Aluminum Wheel Refinishing Finish Damage Evaluation Procedure Important: ^ If the wheels are chrome-plated, do not re-plate or refinish the wheels. ^ If the wheels are polished aluminum, do not refinish the wheels in the dealer environment. Utilize a refinisher that meets manufacturer guidelines. Inspect the wheels for damage from uncoated wheel balance weights or from automatic car wash facilities. 1. Inspect the wheels for the following conditions: ^ Corrosion ^ Scrapes ^ Gouges 2. Verify the damage is not deeper than what sanding can remove. 3. Inspect the wheels for cracks. If a wheel has cracks, discard the wheel. 4. Inspect the wheels for bent rim flanges. If a rim flange is bent, discard the wheel. Refinishing Procedure Caution: To avoid serious personal injury when applying any two part component paint system, follow the specific precautions provided by the paint manufacturer. Failure to follow these precautions may cause lung irritation and allergic respiratory reaction. 1. Remove the tire and wheel assembly from the vehicle. Refer to Tire and Wheel Removal and Installation. 2. Remove the balance weights from the wheel. 3. Remove the tire from the wheel. Refer to Tire Mounting and Dismounting. 4. Use a suitable cleaner in order to remove the following contaminants from the wheel: ^ Lubricants ^ Wax ^ Dirt Important: ^ Do not re-machine the wheel. ^ Do not use chemicals in order to strip the paint from the wheel. Use plastic media blasting in order to remove the paint from the wheel. 5. If the wheel had a machined aluminum finish, spin the wheel and use sand paper in order to restore the circular machined appearance. Important: The wheel mounting surface and the wheel nut contact surface must remain free of paint. 6. Mask the wheel mounting surface and the wheel nut contact surface. 7. Follow the paint manufacturer's instructions for painting the wheel. 8. Unmask the wheel. 9. Install a new valve stem. Important: Use new coated balance weights in order to balance the wheel. 10. Install the tire to the wheel. Refer to Tire Mounting and Dismounting. 11. Use a suitable cleaner in order to remove the following contaminants from the wheel mounting surface: ^ Corrosion ^ Overspray ^ Dirt 12. Install the tire and wheel assembly to the vehicle. Refer to Tire and Wheel Removal and Installation. Page 8839 7. Pressing the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool in the release cavity of the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and crimper in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (DOOR MODULE) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Side view of connector. View of top of connector. 1. Locate the assist lever and lock on the top of the connector. Page 3724 - A control module from another vehicle is installed. - Revised software/calibration files have been released for this vehicle. - IMPORTANT: DO NOT re-program the control module with the SAME software/calibration files that are already present in the control module. This is not an effective repair for any type of concern. Verify that the control module contains the correct software/calibration. If incorrect programming is found, reprogram the control module with the most current software/calibration. Refer to Control Module References for replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Testing for Short to Ground TESTING FOR SHORT TO GROUND NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 4. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit. With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is a short to ground in the circuit. Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2. Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). - When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. - If the DMM does not display voltage 4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is shorted. Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A DIGITAL MULTIMETER NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the powertrain control module (PCM), should only be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200 Digital Multimeter (DMM). The J 39200 instruction manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminage even though voltage is present. The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity. IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading. Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the measurement. Page 6802 For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 8431 8. Insert the J 38125-213 into the small terminal release hole on the nose piece and gently pull on the back of the wire. 9. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Repairing Connector Terminals REPAIRING CONNECTOR TERMINALS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following: Push to Seat terminals - Pull to Seat terminals Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your terminal repair. The J-38125 contains further information. 1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.For cable seal terminals, remove the seal. 2. Apply the correct cable seal per gage size of the wire, if used.Slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation removal. 3. Remove the insulation. 4. For sealed terminals only, align the seal with the end of the cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal.For sealed terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal. 6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.For sealed terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable. 8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals excepting Micro-Pack 100.64 size. Soldering Micro-Pack 100 World terminals may damage the terminal. Sumitomo Connectors SUMITOMO CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 1724 - In some cases Delphi will actually be printed on the connector. If Delphi is not printed on the connector, look for PED. In both cases there is no specific orientation for Delphi or PED and they can appear anywhere on the connector. - FCI connectors may have the FCI logo on their connectors. The logo is the letters FCI with an "A" above it. - JAE connector have JAE in small letters on their connectors. Page 9056 View of typical connector. View of connector in released position. 1. Locate the assist lever at the back of the connector. Move the assist lever to the rear position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the dress cover. Page 1909 Release the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the blue locking tabs on both ends of the connector. Gently slide the TPA up to the released position on both ends. 6. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-13A (GM P/N 12031876-1) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. Page 2261 7. The illustration above identifies the entry canal where the terminal release tool will be inserted, and the terminal cavity. - Terminal (1) - Entry Canal (2) 8. Insert the J-38125-553 (15315247) tool into the entry canal and pry up on the terminal retainer. The terminal retainer is a small plastic piece on the top of the terminal. The terminal retainer must be held up while the terminal is pulled out of the connector. Knock Sensor Replacement (Left Side) Knock Sensor: Service and Repair Knock Sensor Replacement (Left Side) Knock Sensor Replacement (Left Side) Removal Procedure 1. Remove the mounting bolt for the knock sensor 1. 2. Disconnect the electrical connector of the knock sensor from the engine harness (3). 3. Remove the knock sensor (2) from the engine block (4). Installation Procedure 1. Reconnect the engine harness (3) and the knock sensor (2) electrical connectors. 2. Position the knock sensor 2 on the engine block (4). 3. Install the mounting bolt (1) for the knock sensor 2. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 4. Tighten the knock sensor mounting bolt (1). Tighten the knock sensor mounting bolt to 20 N.m (15 lb ft). Page 4238 8. Inspect the sprockets for proper alignment. The mark on the camshaft sprocket (1) should be located in the 6 o'clock position and the mark on the crankshaft sprocket (2) should be located in the 12 o'clock position. 9. Remove the EN 46330. Important: Do not apply threadlock to the flex plate bolts at this time. 10. Temporarily install the automatic transmission flex plate or manual transmission flywheel and bolts. Refer to Engine Flywheel Installation. Page 3520 5. Position the wheel and tire so the valve stem is situated at the 2 o'clock position relative to the head. The tire iron or pry bar can be inserted when prying the outer tire bead up and over the mounting/dismounting head. 6. Position the wheel and tire so that the valve stem is situated again at the 2 o'clock position relative to the head. The tire iron or pry bar can be inserted when prying the inner tire bead up and over the mounting/dismounting head. 7. Remove all residual liquid sealant from the inside of the tire and wheel surfaces. If any tire sealant is noted upon tire dismounting on vehicles equipped with TPM replace the tire pressure sensor. 8. Use a wire brush or coarse steel wool in order to remove any rubber, light rust or corrosion from the wheel bead seats. Important: If bead seat corrosion has been identified as an air loss concern on the wheel being worked on, refer to GM Service Bulletin # 08-03-10-006 for additional information on correcting the leak. 9. Apply GM P/N 12345884 (in Canada, P/N 5728223) or equivalent to the tire bead and the wheel rim. Page 8552 Release the lower wiredress cover locking tab. Release the upper wiredress cover locking tab. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. Page 7767 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. 4. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front of the connector. Page 1742 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the TPA. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the nose piece. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. Page 1706 If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200 DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J 39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected. IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J 39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and maximum (MAX) values measured. 1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of a suspected circuit to the other. 2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J 39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep). IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value in order to record the full change. 5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling the connections or the wiring, test driving, or performing other operations. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions. 6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9. Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist. Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections TESTING FOR INTERMITTENT CONDITIONS AND POOR CONNECTIONS TOOLS REQUIRED - J 35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit - J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit When the condition is not currently present, but is indicated in DTC history, the cause may be intermittent. An intermittent may also be the cause when there is a customer complaint, but the symptom cannot be duplicated. Refer to the Symptom Table of the system that is suspect of causing the condition before trying to locate an intermittent condition. Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the following items: Wiring broken inside the insulation - Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector - Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself, and corrosion in the wire to terminal contact area, etc. - Pierced or damaged insulation can allow moisture to enter the wiring causing corrosion. The conductor can corrode inside the insulation, with little visible evidence. Look for swollen and stiff sections of wire in the suspect circuits. - Wiring which has been pinched, cut, or its insulation rubbed through may cause an intermittent open or short as the bare area touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle. - Wiring that comes in contact with hot or exhaust components - Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required, in order to verify the customer concern. - Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. - Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis and Vehicle Data Recorder operation. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any inline connectors before replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation. Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination, usually in the underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit. Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper adapter. Always use the J 35616 when probing connectors. Other causes of terminal deformation are improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT IN BUSSED ELECTRICAL CENTERS (BEC) Page 8592 Open the harness by removing any tape. 2. Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. 3. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 4. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent american wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 5. Slide a section of high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing down the length of wire to be spliced. Ensure that the shrink tubing will not interfere with the splice procedure. 6. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 7. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. 8. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 9. Insert the wire into the DuraSeal splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 10. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Page 249 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert a small flat-blade tool in the slot below the front loaded terminal position assurance (TPA) and pry up. 3. Remove the TPA by pulling it out of the connector. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-553 (GM P/N 15315247) on a slight upward angle into the cavity below the terminal to be removed. Ensure that the pointed on the end of the tool is facing the bottom of the terminal and it stays in contact with the terminal until it stops on the plastic terminal retainer. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 6676 6. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs located on the opposite side of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover at the connector end and pry up. 7. Remove the dress cover. 8. Cut the tie wrap on the wire bundle. 9. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting a small flat-bladed tool into the small slot in the end of the slider and pushing on the TPA until it comes out of the connector. When the TPA exits the opposite side of the connector, gasp the TPA and pull it completely out of the connector. 10. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 6320 11. Insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) into the 2 triangular cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 12. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE 1. Prior to installation the terminal must be aligned so the (1) coding lugs align with the (2) coding grooves on the connector. 2. Once the terminal is aligned, slide the terminal into the cavity until the retainer has engaged in the cavity of the connector. 3. Slide the TPA in the connector body and seat it using a small flat bladed tool. The TPA is seated when it is flush with the contact housing. 4. Secure the wires to the connector body using a tie wrap and replace the dress cover and grommet. Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) BOSCH CONNECTORS (2.8 JPT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Pull out the slider on the connector position assurance (CPA) until it is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 5277 Page 3275 Release the lower wiredress cover locking tab. Release the upper wiredress cover locking tab. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. Page 1852 Release the tabs that are holding the wiredress cover to the connector body. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the slots on both ends of the connector body. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. J 38125-216 can also be used to remove the nose piece. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by lifting the terminal retaining tabs on the inside of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 5335 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully raise the TPA on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA cannot be removed from the connector while there are terminals present in the connector body. View of the TPA when removed from the connector body. 4. Use the J 38125-12A tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the left side of the terminal release cavity as shown in the graphic. Use the tool to move the terminal release to the right with a gentle prying motion. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 2358 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. JST Connectors JST CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, remove the connector from the component. Page 4419 MOLEX CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. 2. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. Page 2603 4. Use a small flat-blade tool to slide the terminal position assurance (TPA) up one notch on both ends of the connector. The TPA is located underneath the wire dress cover. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 3357 If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200 DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J 39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected. IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J 39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and maximum (MAX) values measured. 1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of a suspected circuit to the other. 2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J 39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep). IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value in order to record the full change. 5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling the connections or the wiring, test driving, or performing other operations. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions. 6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9. Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist. Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections TESTING FOR INTERMITTENT CONDITIONS AND POOR CONNECTIONS TOOLS REQUIRED - J 35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit - J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit When the condition is not currently present, but is indicated in DTC history, the cause may be intermittent. An intermittent may also be the cause when there is a customer complaint, but the symptom cannot be duplicated. Refer to the Symptom Table of the system that is suspect of causing the condition before trying to locate an intermittent condition. Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the following items: Wiring broken inside the insulation - Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector - Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself, and corrosion in the wire to terminal contact area, etc. - Pierced or damaged insulation can allow moisture to enter the wiring causing corrosion. The conductor can corrode inside the insulation, with little visible evidence. Look for swollen and stiff sections of wire in the suspect circuits. - Wiring which has been pinched, cut, or its insulation rubbed through may cause an intermittent open or short as the bare area touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle. - Wiring that comes in contact with hot or exhaust components - Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required, in order to verify the customer concern. - Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. - Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis and Vehicle Data Recorder operation. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any inline connectors before replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation. Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination, usually in the underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit. Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper adapter. Always use the J 35616 when probing connectors. Other causes of terminal deformation are improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT IN BUSSED ELECTRICAL CENTERS (BEC) Page 4783 If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200 DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J 39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected. IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J 39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and maximum (MAX) values measured. 1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of a suspected circuit to the other. 2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J 39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep). IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value in order to record the full change. 5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling the connections or the wiring, test driving, or performing other operations. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions. 6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9. Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist. Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections TESTING FOR INTERMITTENT CONDITIONS AND POOR CONNECTIONS TOOLS REQUIRED - J 35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit - J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit When the condition is not currently present, but is indicated in DTC history, the cause may be intermittent. An intermittent may also be the cause when there is a customer complaint, but the symptom cannot be duplicated. Refer to the Symptom Table of the system that is suspect of causing the condition before trying to locate an intermittent condition. Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the following items: Wiring broken inside the insulation - Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector - Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself, and corrosion in the wire to terminal contact area, etc. - Pierced or damaged insulation can allow moisture to enter the wiring causing corrosion. The conductor can corrode inside the insulation, with little visible evidence. Look for swollen and stiff sections of wire in the suspect circuits. - Wiring which has been pinched, cut, or its insulation rubbed through may cause an intermittent open or short as the bare area touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle. - Wiring that comes in contact with hot or exhaust components - Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required, in order to verify the customer concern. - Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. - Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis and Vehicle Data Recorder operation. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any inline connectors before replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation. Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination, usually in the underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit. Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper adapter. Always use the J 35616 when probing connectors. Other causes of terminal deformation are improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT IN BUSSED ELECTRICAL CENTERS (BEC) Page 5995 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Heated Oxygen and Oxygen Sensor Notice Oxygen Sensor: Service Precautions Heated Oxygen and Oxygen Sensor Notice Heated Oxygen and Oxygen Sensor Notice Notice: Do not remove the pigtail from either the heated oxygen sensor (HO2S) or the oxygen sensor (O2S). Removing the pigtail or the connector will affect sensor operation. Handle the oxygen sensor carefully. Do not drop the HO2S. Keep the in-line electrical connector and the louvered end free of grease, dirt, or other contaminants. Do not use cleaning solvents of any type. Do not repair the wiring, connector or terminals. Replace the oxygen sensor if the pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged. This external clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors, or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degraded sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: * Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. * Do not damage the sensor pigtail and harness wires in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. * Ensure the sensor or vehicle lead wires are not bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends or kinks could block the reference air path through the lead wire. * Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire, where applicable. Vehicles that utilize the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will cause poor engine performance. * Ensure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector in order to prevent damage due to water intrusion. The engine harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air reference being obstructed. Page 1208 4. Compare the fuel tank serial number printed on the fuel tank label (1) to the fuel tank serial number (sequencing) range shown. ^ If the serial number of the tank is not within the ranges above, lower the vehicle. No further action is required. ^ If the serial number of the tank is within the ranges above, remove and replace the fuel sender assembly. Proceed to Step 5 in this bulletin. 5. Remove the fuel tank from the vehicle. Remove the fuel sender assembly from the fuel tank. Refer to Fuel Sender Assembly Replacement in SI. Notice: Ensure that the fuel level sensor pigtail wires are routed through the anti-chafing conduit of the fuel sender assembly to avoid damaging the fuel level sensor pigtail wires. Route the fuel level sensor pigtail wires through the anti-chafing conduit the same way the wires were routed in the old fuel sender assembly. 6. Remove the fuel level sensor from the old fuel sender assembly and install it to the new fuel sender assembly. Refer to Fuel Level Sensor Replacement in SI. 7. Install the fuel sender assembly into the fuel tank and install the fuel tank. Refer to Fuel Sender Assembly Replacement in SI. 8. Lower the vehicle. Claim Information - GM and Saab Canada Only For vehicles repaired under this service update, use the table. Claim Information - US Saab Only Page 5668 to analyze the data during the time a vehicle condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a trigger point that you have determined. Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2 snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a first-in, first-out basis. If a third snapshot is taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost. Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types: Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice - Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200 frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not lost if the Scan Tool is powered down. The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis. The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected values by plotting 3 parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful, especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC. Testing for a Short to Voltage TESTING FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4. Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt, there is a short to voltage in the circuit. Testing for Continuity TESTING FOR CONTINUITY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6. Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit. 7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity. With a Test Lamp IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits. 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6. If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity. Testing for Electrical Intermittents TESTING FOR ELECTRICAL INTERMITTENTS Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment. - Testing for Short to Ground - Testing for Continuity - Testing for a Short to Voltage Page 8070 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link). - The wire insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. 5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold them between thumb and forefinger. 7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place. - Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction. - Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip. 8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool closes.Ensure that no strands of wire are cut. 10. Crimp the splice on each end (2). Locations Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Locations Engine Controls Component Views Accelerator and Brake Pedals 1 - Instrument Panel Harness 2 - Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor 3 - Accelerator Pedal 4 Brake Pedal 5 - Stop Lamp Switch Page 4798 5. Insert the J 38125-557 (GM P/N 12122378) into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 6. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Connector Position Assurance Locks CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of the connector. CPAs are used in various connectors throughout the vehicle. CPAs are also used in all SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals, of the connector. Connector Repairs CONNECTOR REPAIRS Page 2621 7. Pressing the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool in the release cavity of the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and crimper in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (DOOR MODULE) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Side view of connector. View of top of connector. 1. Locate the assist lever and lock on the top of the connector. Page 1474 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Kostal Connectors KOSTAL CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 6874 Checking Aftermarket Accessories CHECKING AFTERMARKET ACCESSORIES Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits: - CAUTION: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol. - NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice. OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol. Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the cause of the problems. Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include: Power feeds connected to points other than the battery - Antenna location - Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring - Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line - Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories. Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions INDUCING INTERMITTENT FAULT CONDITIONS TOOLS REQUIRED J 25070 Heat Gun Many intermittent open or shorted circuits are affected by harness/connector movement that is caused by vibration, engine torque, bumps/rough pavement, etc. In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness if the malfunction appears to be Page 167 Page 1104 Wheel Speed Sensor - RR Page 4628 Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. FCI Connectors FCI CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 8530 6. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs located on the opposite side of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover at the connector end and pry up. 7. Remove the dress cover. 8. Cut the tie wrap on the wire bundle. 9. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting a small flat-bladed tool into the small slot in the end of the slider and pushing on the TPA until it comes out of the connector. When the TPA exits the opposite side of the connector, gasp the TPA and pull it completely out of the connector. 10. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 1656 Page 3277 Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. FCI Connectors FCI CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 4626 Release the lower wiredress cover locking tab. Release the upper wiredress cover locking tab. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. Page 5904 1. Install the MAP sensor (1). Push the MAP sensor into the intake manifold. 2. Install the MAP sensor retainer (2) to the intake manifold. 3. Connect the MAP sensor electrical connector (3). Page 1896 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 8401 - Most Molex connectors will have the Molex logo on the dresscover of the connector. In some cases the connectors may have MX followed by another letter. The third letter indicates where the connector was made. A connector with MXD is a Molex connector made in Detroit. Sumitomo has a unique symbol on their connector and possibly a part number. The symbol is similar to that of a diamond lying on its side, similar to that shown. The logo could appear anywhere but the most common place is at the wire side of the housing. Tyco/AMP has many different and unique connector designs. Some may or may not have identifiable marks on them. Page 2172 If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the DuraSeal splice sleeves. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: - Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. - Do not use the crimp and DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 to crimp DuraSeal splice sleeve. In order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 7335 - A control module from another vehicle is installed. - Revised software/calibration files have been released for this vehicle. - IMPORTANT: DO NOT re-program the control module with the SAME software/calibration files that are already present in the control module. This is not an effective repair for any type of concern. Verify that the control module contains the correct software/calibration. If incorrect programming is found, reprogram the control module with the most current software/calibration. Refer to Control Module References for replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Testing for Short to Ground TESTING FOR SHORT TO GROUND NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 4. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit. With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is a short to ground in the circuit. Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2. Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). - When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. - If the DMM does not display voltage 4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is shorted. Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A DIGITAL MULTIMETER NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the powertrain control module (PCM), should only be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200 Digital Multimeter (DMM). The J 39200 instruction manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminage even though voltage is present. The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity. IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading. Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the measurement. Page 6935 9. The illustration shows a cutaway view of the connector to aid the technician in releasing the terminal retainer. 10. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Terminal Position Assurance Locks TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Tyco/Amp Connectors (CM 42-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (CM 42-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the connector body and pull the CPA out. The CPA is on the wire harness side of connector. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 7813 3. Use a small flat-bladed tool to gently pry off the dress cover by inserting the tool under the cover opposite the harness side and prying up. 4. Remove the cover. 5. Using a small flat-bladed tool, push on the side of the nose piece retainer while pushing the nose piece forward with your thumb. This will release the terminal position assurance (TPA). 6. Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) into the corresponding terminal release cavity. The release cavities are the 2 center rows of cavities on one half of the connector. Page 8150 View of a typical Micro 64 connector. Depress the lock and pull the lever over and past the lock. Page 6994 Body Control Module: Service and Repair Liftgate Control Module Replacement LIFTGATE CONTROL MODULE REPLACEMENT REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Remove the liftgate trim panel. 2. Disconnect the electrical connectors (3) from the module as necessary. 3. Remove the bolts that retain the module to the liftgate. 4. Remove the module from the liftgate. INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 1. Install the module to the liftgate. 2. NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice. Install the bolts that retain the module to the liftgate. Tighten the bolts to 10 N.m (89 lb in). 3. Connect the electrical connectors (3) as necessary. 4. Install the liftgate trim panel. 5. Program the liftgate control module. Refer to Control Module References. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Page 1878 The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors. 1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position. 4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool J 38125-10A (GM P/N 12014012-1) into the front (mating end) of the connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal through the back of the connector (2). IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector. 6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. 7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily. 10. Perform system check. Delphi Connectors (12 Way) DELPHI CONNECTORS (12-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. Page 3910 Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under the 5 year / 100,000 mile (160,000 km) emission warranty, use: Warranty Information (Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 1971 If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200 DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J 39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected. IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J 39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and maximum (MAX) values measured. 1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of a suspected circuit to the other. 2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J 39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep). IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value in order to record the full change. 5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling the connections or the wiring, test driving, or performing other operations. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions. 6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9. Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist. Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections TESTING FOR INTERMITTENT CONDITIONS AND POOR CONNECTIONS TOOLS REQUIRED - J 35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit - J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit When the condition is not currently present, but is indicated in DTC history, the cause may be intermittent. An intermittent may also be the cause when there is a customer complaint, but the symptom cannot be duplicated. Refer to the Symptom Table of the system that is suspect of causing the condition before trying to locate an intermittent condition. Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the following items: Wiring broken inside the insulation - Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector - Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself, and corrosion in the wire to terminal contact area, etc. - Pierced or damaged insulation can allow moisture to enter the wiring causing corrosion. The conductor can corrode inside the insulation, with little visible evidence. Look for swollen and stiff sections of wire in the suspect circuits. - Wiring which has been pinched, cut, or its insulation rubbed through may cause an intermittent open or short as the bare area touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle. - Wiring that comes in contact with hot or exhaust components - Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required, in order to verify the customer concern. - Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. - Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis and Vehicle Data Recorder operation. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any inline connectors before replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation. Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination, usually in the underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit. Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper adapter. Always use the J 35616 when probing connectors. Other causes of terminal deformation are improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT IN BUSSED ELECTRICAL CENTERS (BEC) Antilock Brake System Automated Bleed Procedure Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Antilock Brake System Automated Bleed Procedure Antilock Brake System Automated Bleed Procedure Two - Person Procedure Important: ^ Use the two-person bleed procedure under the following conditions: - Installing a new Electro-Hydraulic Control Unit (EHCU) or new Brake Pressure Modulator Valve (BPMV). - Air is trapped in the valve body. ^ Do not drive the vehicle until the brake pedal feels firm. ^ Do not reuse brake fluid that is used during bleeding. ^ Use the vacuum, the pressure and the gravity bleeding procedures only for base brake bleeding. 1. Raise the vehicle in order to access the system bleed screws. 2. Bleed the system at the right rear wheel first. 3. Install a clear hose on the bleed screw. 4. Immerse the opposite end of the hose into a container partially filled with clean DOT 3 brake fluid. 5. Open the bleed screw 1/2 to 1 full turn. 6. Slowly depress the brake pedal. While the pedal is depressed to its full extent, tighten the bleed screw. 7. Release the brake pedal and wait 10-15 seconds for the master cylinder pistons to return to the home position. 8. Repeat the previous steps for the remaining wheels. The brake fluid which is present at each bleed screw should be clean and free of air. 9. This procedure may use more than a pint of fluid per wheel. Check the master cylinder fluid level every four to six strokes of the brake pedal in order to avoid running the system dry. 10. Press the brake pedal firmly and run the Scan Tool Automated Bleed Procedure. Release the brake pedal between each test. 11. Bleed all four wheels again using Steps 3-9. This will remove the remaining air from the brake system. 12. Evaluate the feel of the brake pedal before attempting to drive the vehicle. 13. Bleed the system as many times as necessary in order to obtain the appropriate feel of the pedal. Diagram Information and Instructions Engine Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions Electrical Symbols Page 709 View of the connector when released from the component. View of another type of Micro 64 connector. Page 5415 to analyze the data during the time a vehicle condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a trigger point that you have determined. Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2 snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a first-in, first-out basis. If a third snapshot is taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost. Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types: Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice - Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200 frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not lost if the Scan Tool is powered down. The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis. The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected values by plotting 3 parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful, especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC. Testing for a Short to Voltage TESTING FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4. Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt, there is a short to voltage in the circuit. Testing for Continuity TESTING FOR CONTINUITY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6. Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit. 7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity. With a Test Lamp IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits. 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6. If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity. Testing for Electrical Intermittents TESTING FOR ELECTRICAL INTERMITTENTS Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment. - Testing for Short to Ground - Testing for Continuity - Testing for a Short to Voltage Page 2633 View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. 4. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers CIRCUIT PROTECTION - CIRCUIT BREAKERS A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types of circuit Page 5652 Page 6425 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (BSK) BOSCH CONNECTORS (BSK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 3. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 4. Insert the J 38125-561 tool into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 5. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is Page 2180 Page 369 Release the tabs that are holding the wiredress cover to the connector body. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the slots on both ends of the connector body. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. J 38125-216 can also be used to remove the nose piece. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by lifting the terminal retaining tabs on the inside of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 4952 4. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the rear of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. 5. Once the locking tabs are unlocked, slide the inner connector out of the rear of the connector housing. Page 7808 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 2054 6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias. Reference the appropriate service manual wiring schematic to obtain the correct diode installation position. 7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for the soldering equipment. 8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed. 9. IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode attachment points with tape. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape. Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable SPLICING TWISTED OR SHIELDED CABLE Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable. 1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splice is made. 3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire. Staggering the splices by 65 mm (2.5 in) is recommended. 4. IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical contact with the drain wire. Re-assemble the cable. Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape. - Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1). - Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire. - Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape. Page 5077 8. Disconnect the 32-way tan electrical connector (2) from the BCM. 9. Disconnect the 24-way gray electrical connector (1) from the BCM. 10. With an upward motion, disconnect the body wiring extension (1) from the rear electrical center. 11. Remove the body wiring extension from the vehicle. INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 1. IMPORTANT: Ensure the sliding latch is fully extended before connecting the body wiring extension to the rear electrical center. Using a downward motion, install the body wiring extension (1) to the rear electrical center. 2. Connect the 24-way gray electrical connector (1) to the BCM. 3. Connect the 32-way tan electrical connector (2) to the BCM. 4. Connect the body wiring extension (1) to the BCM. Page 7976 Service and Repair Air Cleaner Fresh Air Duct/Hose: Service and Repair Air Cleaner Resonator Outlet Duct Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Disconnect the positive crankcase ventilation (PCV) fresh air tube (2) from the air cleaner resonator outlet duct (1). 2. Loosen the clamps at the following: * Mass air flow (MAF)/intake air temperature (IAT) sensor * Throttle body 3. Remove the air cleaner outlet duct bolt. 4. Remove the air cleaner outlet duct. Installation Procedure Page 6673 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. 4. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front of the connector. Page 8679 View of the connector when released from the component. View of another type of Micro 64 connector. Page 2494 5. While pushing the terminal forward, insert the J 38125-24 in the release cavity above the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (43-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Page 4466 Page 8145 - Kostel - Molex - Sumitomo - Tyco/AMP - Yazaki Identifying the manufacturer of a connector is often difficult. When trying to determine the manufacturer of a connector, look for specific identifying marks that are unique to that connector supplier. Most of these identify marks are hard to find or see. Check the connector carefully and refer to the information below for pictures and descriptions of connector identification markings. - Most of AFLs connectors have EPC on their connector body. Some of the smaller connectors will not have any markings on them. - In some cases Bosch will actually be printed on the connector. If Bosch does not appear on the connector, look for the Bosch logo. The Bosch logo is a circle with a blunted arrow inside. This logo can appear anywhere on the connector and is often very small. Page 6936 3. Use a small flat-bladed tool to gently pry off the dress cover by inserting the tool under the cover opposite the harness side and prying up. 4. Remove the cover. 5. Using a small flat-bladed tool, push on the side of the nose piece retainer while pushing the nose piece forward with your thumb. This will release the terminal position assurance (TPA). 6. Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) into the corresponding terminal release cavity. The release cavities are the 2 center rows of cavities on one half of the connector. Page 4973 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link). - The wire insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. 5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold them between thumb and forefinger. 7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place. - Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction. - Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip. 8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool closes.Ensure that no strands of wire are cut. 10. Crimp the splice on each end (2). Page 3415 2. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 5081 6. Engage the sliding latch fastening the BCM to the rear electrical center. Slide the latch outboard until the locking tab (1) is fully seated. 7. Install the rear electrical center cover. 8. If replacing the BCM on a Chevrolet TrailBlazer or GMC Envoy, position the left hand second seat to a passenger position. 9. If replacing the BCM on a Chevrolet TrailBlazer EXT or GMC Envoy XL, install the left second row seat. 10. Connect the negative battery cable. 11. If installing a replacement BCM, program the BCM. Refer to Control Module References. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Page 3088 Brake Fluid: Specifications HYDRAULIC BRAKE SYSTEM Delco Supreme 11 Brake Fluid or equivalent DOT-3 brake fluid. Page 7098 11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the solder equipment. 12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. 13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to cover the first piece of tape. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE SLEEVES TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit IMPORTANT: Use only dura seal splice sleeves. Other splice sleeves may not protect the splice from moisture or provide a good electrical connection. Use duraseal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. Use duraseal splice sleeves where there is special requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire using duraseal splice sleeves. Page 488 Connector Anatomy Connector Repairs contains a list of all connector repairs. The connector repairs are listed by the connector manufacturer and then by connector type. If the technician cannot identify the manufacturer of the connector, refer to Identifying Connectors below. Knowing the connector manufacturer will assist in finding the correct connector repair from the following list: - Connector Position Assurance Locks - Terminal Position Assurance Locks - Bosch Connectors (0.64) Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) Bosch Connectors (BSK) Bosch Connectors (ECM) - Delphi Connectors (Micro.64) Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) Delphi Connectors (12-Way) - Tyco/AMP Connectors (CM 42-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) Tyco/AMP Connectors (025 Cap) Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) - Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) - Repairing Connector Terminals IDENTIFYING CONNECTORS Knowing the connector manufacturer is helpful when trying to locating the correct connector repair procedure. There are many different connector designs used on GM vehicles and it is sometimes difficult to identify the connector manufacturer. The information in this document should help with the identification of connector manufactures. The following connector manufacturers make most of the connectors found in GM vehicles: AFL/EPC (Alcoa Fujikura Ltd./Engineered Plastics Components) - Bosch - Delphi - FCI (Framatome Connectors International) - JAE (Japan Aviation Electronics) - JST (Japan Solderless Terminals) Page 6454 Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. FCI Connectors FCI CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 3110 Fluid - A/T: Testing and Inspection Transmission Fluid Checking This procedure checks the transmission fluid level, as well as the condition of the fluid itself. Notice: Always use the proper automatic transmission fluid listed. Using incorrect automatic transmission fluid may damage the vehicle. Before checking the fluid level, perform the following: 1. Start the engine and park the vehicle on a level surface. Keep the engine running. 2. Apply the parking brake and place the shift lever in PARK (P). 3. Depress the brake pedal and move the shift lever through each gear range, pausing for about 3 seconds in each range. Then, move the shift lever back to PARK (P). 4. Allow the engine to idle 500-800 rpm for at least 1 minute. Slowly release the brake pedal. 5. Keep the engine running and observe the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) using the Driver Information Center (DIC) or a scan tool. 6. Using the TFT reading, determine and perform the appropriate check procedure. If the TFT reading is not within the required temperature ranges, allow the vehicle to cool, or operate the vehicle until the appropriate TFT is reached. Cold Check Procedure Important: Use the cold check procedure only as a reference to determine if the transmission has enough fluid to be operated safely until a hot check procedure can be made. The hot check procedure is the most accurate method to check the fluid level. Perform the hot check procedure at the first opportunity. Use this cold check procedure to check fluid level when the TFT is between 80° F and 90° F (27° C and 32° C). 1. Start the engine and locate the transmission dipstick at the rear of the engine compartment, on the passenger's side of the vehicle. 2. Flip the handle up, and then pull out the dipstick and wipe the dipstick end with a clean rag or paper towel. 3. Install the dipstick by pushing it back in the dipstick tube all the way, wait three seconds and then pull it back out again. Important: Always check the fluid level at least twice. Consistent readings are important to maintaining proper fluid level. If inconsistent readings are noted, inspect the transmission vent assembly to ensure it is clean and unclogged. 4. Keep the dipstick pointing down and check both sides of the dipstick, and read the lower level. Repeat the check procedure to verify the reading. 5. Inspect the color of the fluid on the dipstick. Refer to Fluid Condition Inspection. 6. If the fluid level is below the COLD check line, add only enough fluid as necessary to bring the level into the COLD line. It does not take much fluid, generally less than one pint (0.5L). Do not overfill. 7. If the fluid level is in the acceptable range, push the dipstick back in all the way, then flip the handle down to lock the dipstick in place. 8. Perform a hot check at the first opportunity after the transmission reaches a normal operating temperature between 180° F to 200° F (82° C to 93° C). Hot Check Procedure Important: Use this procedure to check the transmission fluid level when the TFT is between 180° F and 200° F (82° C and 93° C). The hot check procedure is the most accurate method to check the fluid level. The hot check should be performed at the first opportunity in order to verify the cold check. The fluid level rises as fluid temperature increases, so it is important to ensure the transmission temperature is within range. 1. Start the engine and locate the transmission dipstick at the rear of the engine compartment, on the passenger's's side of the vehicle. 2. Flip the handle up, and then pull out the dipstick and wipe the dipstick end with a clean rag or paper towel. 3. Install the dipstick by pushing it back in the dipstick tube all the way, wait three seconds and then pull it back out. Important: Always check the fluid level at least twice. Consistent readings are important to maintaining proper fluid level. If inconsistent readings are noted, inspect the transmission vent assembly to ensure it is clean and unclogged. 4. Keep the dipstick tip pointing down and check both sides of the dipstick. Read the lower level. Repeat the check procedure to verify the reading. 5. Inspect the color of the fluid on the dipstick. Refer to Fluid Condition Inspection. 6. A safe operating fluid level is within the HOT crosshatch band on the dipstick. If the fluid level is not within the HOT band, and the transmission temperature is between 180° F and 200° F (82° C and 93° C), add or drain fluid as necessary to bring the level into the HOT band. If the fluid level is low, add only enough fluid to bring the level into the HOT band. Important: To assist in reaching the correct temperature range of 180° F to 200° F (82° C and 93° C), drive the vehicle in second gear at no more than 65 MPH until the desired temperature is reached. Page 6073 Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested: - Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. - Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a component or to other harnesses. - If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A TEST LAMP TOOLS REQUIRED J 35616-200 Test Light - Probe Kit NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminate even though voltage is present. The J 35616-200 is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair of leads. To properly operate this tool use the following procedures. When testing for voltage: 1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested. When testing for ground: 1. Attach one lead to battery positive voltage. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where ground should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is ground at the point being tested. Using Connector Test Adapters USING CONNECTOR TEST ADAPTERS NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Using Fused Jumper Wires USING FUSED JUMPER WIRES TOOLS REQUIRED J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged. The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested. AFL/ECP Connectors AFL/EPC CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Specifications Compression Check: Specifications Compression Check Start with the compression gage at zero and crank the engine through 4 compression strokes, 4 puffs. Measure the compression for each cylinder. Record the readings. If a cylinder has low compression, inject approximately 15 ml (1 tablespoon) of engine oil into the combustion chamber through the spark plug hole. Measure the compression again and record the reading. The minimum compression in any 1 cylinder should not be less than 70 percent of the highest cylinder. No cylinder should read less than 690 kPa (100 psi). For example, if the highest pressure in any 1 cylinder is 1,035 kPa (150 psi), the lowest allowable pressure for any other cylinder would be 725 kPa (105 psi). (1 035 x 70% = 725) (150 x 70% = 105). Page 3119 Page 458 Page 2214 Release the tabs that are holding the wiredress cover to the connector body. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the slots on both ends of the connector body. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. J 38125-216 can also be used to remove the nose piece. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by lifting the terminal retaining tabs on the inside of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 6083 6. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs located on the opposite side of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover at the connector end and pry up. 7. Remove the dress cover. 8. Cut the tie wrap on the wire bundle. 9. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting a small flat-bladed tool into the small slot in the end of the slider and pushing on the TPA until it comes out of the connector. When the TPA exits the opposite side of the connector, gasp the TPA and pull it completely out of the connector. 10. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 6601 Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size. REPAIRING A FUSIBLE LINK IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient overload protection. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. Flat Wire Repairs FLAT WIRE REPAIRS NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced. GMLAN Wiring Repairs GMLAN WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The GM Local Area Network (GMLAN) System requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working on GMLAN connectors and terminals. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items in order to repair the GMLAN wiring: Dura Seal splice sleeves - A wire stripping tool - J 38125-8 Crimping Tool (GM P/N 12085115) - J 38125-5 Ultra Torch Special Tool (GM P/N 12085116) The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. - A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors GMLAN REPAIRS IMPORTANT: When making a repair to any GMLAN network, the original wire length after the repair must be the same length as before the repair. If the network is a twisted pair, the twist must be maintained after the repair is completed. GMLAN has 2 types of networks, low speed and high speed. Low speed GMLAN has a single wire and works at slow speeds. High speed GMLAN has 2 wires in a twisted pair and works at higher speeds. For more information on GMLAN, refer to Data Link Communications Description and Operation. GMLAN CONNECTOR TERMINAL REPAIR IMPORTANT: A service terminal can be used to replace damaged connector terminals for both high speed and low speed GMLAN systems. When making a connector terminal repair on a GMLAN high speed system with twisted pair wires, do not untwist the wires more than necessary to make the repair. The terminals in the GMLAN system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are available in the J-38125. If the individual terminals are damaged on any GMLAN connection, use the appropriate connector repair procedure in order to repair the terminal. GMLAN WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 7648 REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. The release tab is located on the top of the wiredress cover. View of connector in released position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Page 1580 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. 4. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front of the connector. Page 8677 - Yazaki has a wedge or arrow shape, similar to that shown. Delphi Connectors (Micro .64) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro 64 connectors. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. The lever lock may be located on the top or sides of the wire dress cover. Page 1149 For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 905 6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias. Reference the appropriate service manual wiring schematic to obtain the correct diode installation position. 7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for the soldering equipment. 8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed. 9. IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode attachment points with tape. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape. Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable SPLICING TWISTED OR SHIELDED CABLE Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable. 1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splice is made. 3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire. Staggering the splices by 65 mm (2.5 in) is recommended. 4. IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical contact with the drain wire. Re-assemble the cable. Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape. - Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1). - Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire. - Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape. Page 5434 - In some cases Delphi will actually be printed on the connector. If Delphi is not printed on the connector, look for PED. In both cases there is no specific orientation for Delphi or PED and they can appear anywhere on the connector. - FCI connectors may have the FCI logo on their connectors. The logo is the letters FCI with an "A" above it. - JAE connector have JAE in small letters on their connectors. Page 8882 Page 8695 4. Use a small flat-blade tool to slide the terminal position assurance (TPA) up one notch on both ends of the connector. The TPA is located underneath the wire dress cover. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Tires/Wheels - Low Tire/Leaking Cast Aluminum Wheels Wheels: Customer Interest Tires/Wheels - Low Tire/Leaking Cast Aluminum Wheels TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 05-03-10-003F Date: April 27, 2010 Subject: Low Tire Pressure, Leaking Cast Aluminum Wheels (Repair with Adhesive Sealant) Models: 2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X with Cast Aluminum Wheels Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the model years and the bulletin reference information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 05-03-10-003E (Section 03 - Suspension). Condition Some customers may comment on a low tire pressure condition. Diagnosis of the low tire pressure condition indicates an air leak through the cast aluminum wheel. Cause Porosity in the cast aluminum wheel may be the cause. Notice This bulletin specifically addresses issues related to the wheel casting that may result in an air leak. For issues related to corrosion of the wheel in service, please refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 08-03-10-006C - Tire Slowly Goes Flat, Tire Air Loss, Low Tire Pressure Warning Light Illuminated, Aluminum Wheel Bead Seat Corrosion (Clean and Resurface Wheel Bead Seat). Correction 1. Remove the tire and wheel assembly from the vehicle. Refer to the appropriate service procedure in SI. 2. Locate the leaking area by inflating the tire to 276 kPa (40 psi) and dipping the tire/wheel assembly in a water bath, or use a spray bottle with soap and water to locate the specific leak location. Important - If the porosity leak is located in the bead area of the aluminum rim (where the tire meets the rim), the wheel should be replaced. - If two or more leaks are located on one wheel, the wheel should be replaced. 3. If air bubbles are observed, mark the location. - If the leak location is on the tire/rubber area, refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 04-03-10-001F Tire Puncture Repair Procedures for All Cars and Light Duty Trucks. - If the leak is located on the aluminum wheel area, continue with the next step. 4. Inscribe a mark on the tire at the valve stem in order to indicate the orientation of the tire to the wheel. 5. Dismount the tire from the wheel. Refer to Tire Mounting and Dismounting. 6. Remove the tire pressure sensor. Refer to Tire Pressure Sensor removal procedure in SI. 7. Scuff the INSIDE rim surface at the leak area with #80 grit paper and clean the area with general purpose cleaner, such as 3M(R) General Purpose Adhesive Cleaner, P/N 08984, or equivalent. 8. Apply a 3 mm (0.12 in) thick layer of Silicone - Adhesive/Sealant, P/N 12378478 (in Canada, use 88900041), or equivalent, to the leak area. 9. Allow for the adhesive/sealant to dry. Notice Caution must be used when mounting the tire so as not to damage the sealer. Damaging the repair area may result in an air leak. Page 7054 Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. FCI Connectors FCI CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 5729 6. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by pressing on the tang. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (SENSOR) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) tool into the cavity on the lower right hand face of the connector until the terminal release tang access panel slides over. Page 8457 11. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 12. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 13. Center the high temperature SCT1 shrink tube over the DuraSeal splice sleeve. 14. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the high temperature heat shrink tubing. 15. Gradually move the heat from the center to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 16. Replace any reflective tape and clips that may have been remove during the repair. Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation REPAIRING DAMAGED WIRE INSULATION Wire Size Conversion Specifications Fuel Pressure: Specifications Fuel Pressure (Key ON, Engine OFF).................................................................................................. ..............................................345-414 kPa (50-60 psi) Page 861 4. Use a small flat-blade tool to slide the terminal position assurance (TPA) up one notch on both ends of the connector. The TPA is located underneath the wire dress cover. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 5260 8. Install the ECM/TCM cover. 9. Ensure the ECM/TCM cover retainers (1) are fully engaged to the ECM/TCM bracket. 10. Connect the cooling fan electrical connector. 11. Connect the negative battery cable. 12. If the ECM was replaced the replacement ECM must be programmed. Refer to Control Module References. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Page 5310 - Kostel - Molex - Sumitomo - Tyco/AMP - Yazaki Identifying the manufacturer of a connector is often difficult. When trying to determine the manufacturer of a connector, look for specific identifying marks that are unique to that connector supplier. Most of these identify marks are hard to find or see. Check the connector carefully and refer to the information below for pictures and descriptions of connector identification markings. - Most of AFLs connectors have EPC on their connector body. Some of the smaller connectors will not have any markings on them. - In some cases Bosch will actually be printed on the connector. If Bosch does not appear on the connector, look for the Bosch logo. The Bosch logo is a circle with a blunted arrow inside. This logo can appear anywhere on the connector and is often very small. Page 4788 3. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. View showing depressing of the lever lock release tab. Page 1335 - In some cases Delphi will actually be printed on the connector. If Delphi is not printed on the connector, look for PED. In both cases there is no specific orientation for Delphi or PED and they can appear anywhere on the connector. - FCI connectors may have the FCI logo on their connectors. The logo is the letters FCI with an "A" above it. - JAE connector have JAE in small letters on their connectors. Page 8644 Page 220 Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. FCI Connectors FCI CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 5505 Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair Mass Airflow Sensor/Intake Air Temperature Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure Important: Use care when handling the mass air flow (MAF)/intake air temperature (IAT) sensor. Do not dent, puncture, or otherwise damage the honeycell located at the air inlet end of the MAF/IAT. Do not touch the sensing elements or allow anything including cleaning solvents and lubricants to come in contact with them. Use a small amount of a non-silicone based lubricant, on the air duct only, to aid in installation. 1. Disconnect the MAF/IAT sensor electrical connector. 2. Loosen the clamps at the MAF/IAT sensor and the throttle body. 3. Remove the air cleaner outlet duct bolt. 4. Remove the air cleaner outlet duct. 5. Loosen the clamp attaching the MAF/IAT sensor to the air cleaner housing. 6. Remove the MAF/IAT sensor from the air cleaner housing. Installation Procedure Important: The embossed arrow on the MAF/IAT sensor indicates the proper air flow direction. The arrow must point toward the engine. Page 944 Air Bag Control Module: Diagrams SIR Connector End Views Inflatable Restraint Sensing and Diagnostic Module (SDM) Page 2284 If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs SIR/SRS WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS, and the wiring components, such as connectors and terminals. IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system terminals. Use either an SIR/SRS pigtail or a terminated lead from the SIR Repair Kit Tray. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves, in order to repair the SIR/SRS wiring - A special crimping tool - A heat torch - An instruction manual The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides the necessary low resistance contact integrity for these sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors SIR/SRS CONNECTOR REPAIR (PLASTIC BODY AND TERMINAL METAL PIN) The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made with a special plating. This plating provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. Use the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit for repairing SIR/SRS terminals and connectors. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the repair kit. The J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit contains: Various terminated leads for sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) terminal replacement - Various connector positive assurance (CPA) locks for SIR/SRS connectors - Base of steering column pigtail connectors part number 12085514 - Yellow vinyl electrical tape Pigtail repair packs are available for SIR/SRS connectors with eight or less terminals. Only the connector body is available for connectors with more than eight terminals. The terminated leads in the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit can be used to replace damaged terminals when replacing the connector body. SIR/SRS COMPONENT WIRE PIGTAIL REPAIR IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails. A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device, not by a connector. If a wiring pigtail is damaged, you must replace the entire component, with pigtail. The inflatable restraint steering wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component. SIR/SRS WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 8052 2. Use a small flat-bladed tool to release the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting the tool in the small recess on the side of the connector and pushing up until the TPA releases from the connector body. The TPA should raise just slightly. Do not try to remove the TPA. IMPORTANT: The TPA on this connector cannot be removed unless the terminals are removed first. The TPA will come out of the connector body, but only slightly. When the TPA is slightly raised the terminals can be removed. Using excessive force to remove the TPA with the terminals still in the connector will damage the connector. 3. Repeat the process for the other side of the connector. 4. Ensure that the TPA is in the proper position to remove the terminals. Page 8433 3. Remove the dress cover by using a flat-blade tool to release the connector locking tabs and pulling off the dress cover. 4. Relieve the tension on the nose piece retainers by inserting J-38125-12A (12094429) into the single retainer slot on the end of the nose piece and gently prying out the locking tab. Repeat the process for both of the nose piece locking tabs on the opposite side of the nose piece. Page 3433 11. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 12. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 13. Center the high temperature SCT1 shrink tube over the DuraSeal splice sleeve. 14. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the high temperature heat shrink tubing. 15. Gradually move the heat from the center to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 16. Replace any reflective tape and clips that may have been remove during the repair. Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation REPAIRING DAMAGED WIRE INSULATION Wire Size Conversion Page 7476 Refer to the following table as a guide in selecting the correct test adapter for front probing connectors: Backprobe IMPORTANT: Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures. - Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector. - Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large of a test probe. - After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected, test for proper terminal contact. Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the connector. Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure SCAN TOOL SNAPSHOT PROCEDURE Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used Page 8054 Release the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the blue locking tabs on both ends of the connector. Gently slide the TPA up to the released position on both ends. 6. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-13A (GM P/N 12031876-1) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. Page 2597 The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors. 1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position. 4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool J 38125-10A (GM P/N 12014012-1) into the front (mating end) of the connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal through the back of the connector (2). IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector. 6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. 7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily. 10. Perform system check. Delphi Connectors (12 Way) DELPHI CONNECTORS (12-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. Page 4832 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry one side of the nose piece up to the pre-stage position. When the nose piece is in the pre-staged position, the nose piece will be raised above the connector body the length of the step in the nose piece. 7. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry the other side of the piece to the pre-stage position. If the nose piece is higher than the first step in the nose piece, gently push down on the nose piece until it meets with resistance from the connector body, you should feel the nose piece click into position. Page 6843 Spark Plug: Testing and Inspection Spark Plug Inspection * Verify that the correct spark plug is installed. An incorrect spark plug causes driveability conditions. Refer to Ignition System Specifications for the correct spark plug. * Ensure that the spark plug has the correct heat range. An incorrect heat range causes the following conditions: - Spark plug fouling - Colder plug - Pre-ignition causing spark plug and/or engine damage - Hotter plug * Inspect the terminal post (1) for damage. - Inspect for a bent or broken terminal post (1) - Test for a loose terminal post (1) by twisting and pulling the post. The terminal post should not move. * Inspect the insulator (2) for flashover or carbon tracking, or soot. This is caused by the electrical charge traveling across the insulator between the terminal post (1) and ground. Inspect for the following conditions: - Inspect the spark plug boot for damage. - Inspect the spark plug recess are of the cylinder head for moisture, such as oil, coolant, or water. A spark plug boot that is saturated will cause arcing to ground. * Inspect the insulator (2) for cracks. All or part of the electrical charge may arc through the crack instead of the electrodes (3,4). Page 4584 Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Page 5370 If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs SIR/SRS WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS, and the wiring components, such as connectors and terminals. IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system terminals. Use either an SIR/SRS pigtail or a terminated lead from the SIR Repair Kit Tray. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves, in order to repair the SIR/SRS wiring - A special crimping tool - A heat torch - An instruction manual The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides the necessary low resistance contact integrity for these sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors SIR/SRS CONNECTOR REPAIR (PLASTIC BODY AND TERMINAL METAL PIN) The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made with a special plating. This plating provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. Use the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit for repairing SIR/SRS terminals and connectors. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the repair kit. The J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit contains: Various terminated leads for sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) terminal replacement - Various connector positive assurance (CPA) locks for SIR/SRS connectors - Base of steering column pigtail connectors part number 12085514 - Yellow vinyl electrical tape Pigtail repair packs are available for SIR/SRS connectors with eight or less terminals. Only the connector body is available for connectors with more than eight terminals. The terminated leads in the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit can be used to replace damaged terminals when replacing the connector body. SIR/SRS COMPONENT WIRE PIGTAIL REPAIR IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails. A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device, not by a connector. If a wiring pigtail is damaged, you must replace the entire component, with pigtail. The inflatable restraint steering wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component. SIR/SRS WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 3254 11. Insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) into the 2 triangular cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 12. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE 1. Prior to installation the terminal must be aligned so the (1) coding lugs align with the (2) coding grooves on the connector. 2. Once the terminal is aligned, slide the terminal into the cavity until the retainer has engaged in the cavity of the connector. 3. Slide the TPA in the connector body and seat it using a small flat bladed tool. The TPA is seated when it is flush with the contact housing. 4. Secure the wires to the connector body using a tie wrap and replace the dress cover and grommet. Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) BOSCH CONNECTORS (2.8 JPT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Pull out the slider on the connector position assurance (CPA) until it is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Exhaust Manifold Replacement - Left Side Exhaust Manifold: Service and Repair Exhaust Manifold Replacement - Left Side Exhaust Manifold Replacement - Left Side Removal Procedure 1. Raise and suitably support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 2. Remove the nuts securing the catalytic converter to the left exhaust manifold. 3. Lower the vehicle. 4. Remove the spark plugs. Refer to Spark Plug Replacement for the 5.3L engine or Spark Plug Replacement for the 6.0L engine. 5. Remove the heat shield bolts, and shield from the exhaust manifold. 6. Remove the exhaust manifold bolts, manifold, and gasket. 7. Discard the gasket. 8. Clean and inspect the exhaust manifold. Refer to Exhaust Manifold Cleaning and Inspection for the 5.3L engine or Exhaust Manifold Cleaning and Inspection for the 6.0L engine. Installation Procedure Important: ^ Tighten the exhaust manifold bolts as specified in the service procedure. Improperly installed and/or leaking exhaust manifold gaskets may affect vehicle emissions and/or On-Board Diagnostics (OBD) II system performance. ^ The cylinder head exhaust manifold bolt hole threads must be clean and free of debris or threadlocking material. Page 8130 - A control module from another vehicle is installed. - Revised software/calibration files have been released for this vehicle. - IMPORTANT: DO NOT re-program the control module with the SAME software/calibration files that are already present in the control module. This is not an effective repair for any type of concern. Verify that the control module contains the correct software/calibration. If incorrect programming is found, reprogram the control module with the most current software/calibration. Refer to Control Module References for replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Testing for Short to Ground TESTING FOR SHORT TO GROUND NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 4. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit. With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is a short to ground in the circuit. Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2. Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). - When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. - If the DMM does not display voltage 4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is shorted. Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A DIGITAL MULTIMETER NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the powertrain control module (PCM), should only be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200 Digital Multimeter (DMM). The J 39200 instruction manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminage even though voltage is present. The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity. IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading. Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the measurement. Page 2460 7. Apply pressure and gently rock the cover until one locking leg is unseated. 8. Continue to apply pressure and rock the cover until the second locking leg is unseated. Repeat procedure for the other side of the dress cover and remove the cover. 9. Use J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) to gently lift the terminal retaining tab while gently pulling the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 10. If the terminal is severely bent or damaged, it may be possible on some connectors to push the wire out of the front of the connector instead of Page 3188 Disclaimer Page 6531 It is very important to use the correct test adapter when testing for proper terminal contact of fuses and relays in a bussed electrical center (BEC). Use J-35616-35 to test for proper terminal contact. Failure to use J-35616-35 can result in improper diagnosis of the BEC. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Separate the connector halves. 2. Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body. 3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J-38125 , test that the retention force is significantly different between a good terminal and a suspect terminal. Replace the female terminal in question. FLAT WIRE (DOCK AND LOCK) CONNECTORS There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock) connectors on the harness side or the component side. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Remove the component in question. 2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side of the connector as oil from your skin may be a source of contamination as well. 3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other imperfections that could cause poor terminal contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are uniform and free of damage or deformation. 4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the on the flat wire harness connector in order to test the circuit in question. CONTROL MODULE/COMPONENT VOLTAGE AND GROUNDS Poor voltage or ground connections can cause widely varying symptoms. Test all control module voltage supply circuits. Many vehicles have multiple circuits supplying voltage to a control module. Other components in the system may have separate voltage supply circuits that may also need to be tested. Inspect connections at the module/component connectors, fuses, and any intermediate connections between the voltage source and the module/component. A test lamp or a DMM may indicate that voltage is present, but neither tests the ability of the circuit to carry sufficient current. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Power Distribution Schematics. - Test all control module ground and system ground circuits. The control module may have multiple ground circuits. Other components in the system may have separate grounds that may also need to be tested. Inspect grounds for clean and tight connections at the grounding point. Inspect the connections at the component and in splice packs, where applicable. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Ground Distribution Schematics. TEMPERATURE SENSITIVITY - An intermittent condition may occur when a component/connection reaches normal operating temperature. The condition may occur only when the component/connection is cold, or only when the component/connection is hot. - Freeze Frame, Failure Records, Snapshot, or Vehicle Data Recorder data may help with this type of intermittent condition, where applicable. - If the intermittent is related to heat, review the data for a relationship with the following: High ambient temperatures - Underhood/engine generated heat - Circuit generated heat due to a poor connection, or high electrical load - Higher than normal load conditions, towing, etc. - If the intermittent is related to cold, review the data for the following: Low ambient temperatures-In extremely low temperatures, ice may form in a connection or component. Inspect for water intrusion. - The condition only occurs on a cold start. - The condition goes away when the vehicle warms up. - Information from the customer may help to determine if the trouble follows a pattern that is temperature related. - If temperature is suspected of causing an intermittent fault condition, attempt to duplicate the condition. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required. ELECTROMAGNETIC INTERFERENCE (EMI) AND ELECTRICAL NOISE Some electrical components/circuits are sensitive to electromagnetic interference (EMI) or other types of electrical noise. Inspect for the following conditions: A misrouted harness that is too close to high voltage/high current devices such as secondary ignition components, motors, generator etc-These components may induce electrical noise on a circuit that could interfere with normal circuit operation. - Electrical system interference caused by a malfunctioning relay, or a control module driven solenoid or switch-These conditions can cause a sharp electrical surge. Normally, the condition will occur when the malfunctioning component is operating. - Improper installation of non-factory or aftermarket add on accessories such as lights, 2-way radios, amplifiers, electric motors, remote starters, alarm systems, cell phones, etc-These accessories may lead to interference while in use, but do not fail when the accessories are not in use. - Test for an open diode across the A/C compressor clutch and for other open diodes. Some relays may contain a clamping diode. - The generator may be allowing AC noise into the electrical system. INCORRECT CONTROL MODULE - There are only a few situations where reprogramming a control module is appropriate: A new service control module is installed. Page 3245 3. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. View showing depressing of the lever lock release tab. Locations Accelerator And Brake Pedals Page 1894 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry one side of the nose piece up to the pre-stage position. When the nose piece is in the pre-staged position, the nose piece will be raised above the connector body the length of the step in the nose piece. 7. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry the other side of the piece to the pre-stage position. If the nose piece is higher than the first step in the nose piece, gently push down on the nose piece until it meets with resistance from the connector body, you should feel the nose piece click into position. Page 4753 3. Radiator outlet hose (lower hose) to engine (3). (Shown as viewed from below.) 4. Radiator outlet hose (lower hose) to radiator (4). (Shown as viewed from below.) 5. Heater inlet hose to engine (5). Page 4971 If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the DuraSeal splice sleeves. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: - Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. - Do not use the crimp and DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 to crimp DuraSeal splice sleeve. In order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 466 Checking Aftermarket Accessories CHECKING AFTERMARKET ACCESSORIES Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits: - CAUTION: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol. - NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice. OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol. Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the cause of the problems. Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include: Power feeds connected to points other than the battery - Antenna location - Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring - Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line - Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories. Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions INDUCING INTERMITTENT FAULT CONDITIONS TOOLS REQUIRED J 25070 Heat Gun Many intermittent open or shorted circuits are affected by harness/connector movement that is caused by vibration, engine torque, bumps/rough pavement, etc. In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness if the malfunction appears to be ABS/TCS - StabiliTrak(R) Indicator Blinking/DTC C0196 Electronic Brake Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins ABS/TCS - StabiliTrak(R) Indicator Blinking/DTC C0196 TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 08-05-25-005 Date: October 01, 2008 Subject: Intermittent StabiliTrak(R) Indicator Light Blinking, StabiliTrak(R) Active Message Displayed, DTC C0196 Set (Reprogram Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM)) Models: 2006-2007 Buick Rainier 2006-2009 Chevrolet TrailBlazer Models 2006-2009 GMC Envoy Models 2006-2009 Saab 97X 2006-2009 Isuzu Ascender Models This bulletin provides information on two different conditions. Condition # 1 Some customers may comment on a Service StabiliTrak(R) indicator light along with a Service StabiliTrak(R) message displayed in the DIC. Upon investigation, the technician may find DTC C0196 set in history. Condition # 2 Some customers may comment on a blinking StabiliTrak(R) indicator light along with a StabiliTrak Active message displayed in the DIC during normal driving conditions. No DTCs will be found with this concern. Cause This condition may be caused by a software anomaly within the electronic brake control module (EBCM) that allowed the yaw offset to be falsely learned. Correction Important: From the controller list, select "VSES Vehicle Stability Enhancement System Control Module". If routine diagnosis using SI does not reveal any obvious cause, reprogram the EBCM using SPS with the latest software available on TIS2WEB. Refer to the Service Programming System (SPS) procedures in SI. As always, make sure your Tech 2(R) is updated with the latest software version. Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models) Locations Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Locations Engine Controls Component Views Accelerator and Brake Pedals 1 - Instrument Panel Harness 2 - Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor 3 - Accelerator Pedal 4 Brake Pedal 5 - Stop Lamp Switch Page 5051 Heat Shield: Service and Repair Exhaust Manifold Heat Shield Replacement Exhaust Manifold Heat Shield Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Remove the air cleaner outlet resonator. Refer to Air Cleaner Outlet Resonator Replacement. 2. Remove the transmission filler tube stud nut from the secondary air injection (AIR) adapter and move the filler out of the way. 3. Remove the oil level indicator tube. Refer to Oil Level Indicator and Tube Replacement. 4. Remove the oxygen sensor from the exhaust manifold. Refer to Heated Oxygen Sensor 1 Replacement. 5. Remove the 4 manifold heat shield nuts and remove the heat shield. Installation Procedure Page 5930 Diagram Information and Instructions Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions Electrical Symbols Page 2625 3. Ensure that the terminal release tang access panel is in the correct location to access the terminals. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) into the terminal release tang access slot located behind the access panel of the connector and press down on the terminal while carefully pulling the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Tyco/AMP Connectors (0.25 Cap) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (025 CAP) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component by pressing down on the connector position assurance (CPA). Page 6537 Release the tabs that are holding the wiredress cover to the connector body. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the slots on both ends of the connector body. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. J 38125-216 can also be used to remove the nose piece. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by lifting the terminal retaining tabs on the inside of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 2562 Refer to the following table as a guide in selecting the correct test adapter for front probing connectors: Backprobe IMPORTANT: Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures. - Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector. - Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large of a test probe. - After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected, test for proper terminal contact. Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the connector. Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure SCAN TOOL SNAPSHOT PROCEDURE Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used Page 7222 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert a small flat-blade tool in the slot below the front loaded terminal position assurance (TPA) and pry up. 3. Remove the TPA by pulling it out of the connector. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-553 (GM P/N 15315247) on a slight upward angle into the cavity below the terminal to be removed. Ensure that the pointed on the end of the tool is facing the bottom of the terminal and it stays in contact with the terminal until it stops on the plastic terminal retainer. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 8694 REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. The release tab is located on the top of the wiredress cover. View of connector in released position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Specifications Water Pump: Specifications Important: All gasket surfaces are to be free of oil or other foreign material during assembly. Install the water pump and NEW gaskets. Install the water pump bolts. On the initial pass, tighten the bolts to ................................................................................................................................................... 15 N.m (11 lb ft). On the final pass, tighten the bolts to ..................................................................................................................................................... 30 N.m (22 lb ft). Heated Oxygen Sensor Replacement - Bank 1 Sensor 1 Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Heated Oxygen Sensor Replacement - Bank 1 Sensor 1 Heated Oxygen Sensor Replacement - Bank 1 Sensor 1 Removal Procedure Notice: Refer to Heated Oxygen and Oxygen Sensor Notice. Notice: Refer to Excessive Force and Oxygen Sensor Notice. 1. Raise and suitably support the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Unscrew the heated oxygen sensor (HO2S) sensor from the catalytic converter. 3. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) retainer. 4. Disconnect the HO2S electrical connector (3). Installation Procedure Page 1498 6. Gently pry the plastic terminal retainer down and carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (16-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, pull the two connector halves apart. Page 4643 3. Remove the dress cover by using a flat-blade tool to release the connector locking tabs and pulling off the dress cover. 4. Relieve the tension on the nose piece retainers by inserting J-38125-12A (12094429) into the single retainer slot on the end of the nose piece and gently prying out the locking tab. Repeat the process for both of the nose piece locking tabs on the opposite side of the nose piece. Page 6372 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert a small flat-blade tool in the slot below the front loaded terminal position assurance (TPA) and pry up. 3. Remove the TPA by pulling it out of the connector. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-553 (GM P/N 15315247) on a slight upward angle into the cavity below the terminal to be removed. Ensure that the pointed on the end of the tool is facing the bottom of the terminal and it stays in contact with the terminal until it stops on the plastic terminal retainer. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 7444 Important: Never reuse the old seal or a fuel leak may occur. Always use a NEW seal. 1. Install a NEW seal (3) onto the fuel tank. Important: Place the fuel pump strainer in a horizontal position when you install the fuel sender in the tank. When installing the fuel sender assembly, assure that the fuel pump strainer does not block full travel of the float arm. 2. Install the fuel sender assembly (2). Important: Always replace the fuel sender seal when installing the fuel sender assembly. Replace the lock ring if necessary. Do not apply any type of lubrication in the seal groove. Ensure the lock ring is installed with the correct side facing upward. A correctly installed lock ring will only turn in a clockwise direction. 3. Use the J45722 in order to install the fuel sender lock ring. Turn the fuel sender lock ring in a clockwise direction. Page 6710 MOLEX CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. 2. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. Page 8068 If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the DuraSeal splice sleeves. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: - Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. - Do not use the crimp and DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 to crimp DuraSeal splice sleeve. In order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 4020 12. Remove the engine mount with the upper engine mount bracket as an assembly. 13. Separate the engine mount from the upper engine mount bracket. 14. Remove the engine mount bracket spacer if damaged. Installation Procedure Page 7173 - Kostel - Molex - Sumitomo - Tyco/AMP - Yazaki Identifying the manufacturer of a connector is often difficult. When trying to determine the manufacturer of a connector, look for specific identifying marks that are unique to that connector supplier. Most of these identify marks are hard to find or see. Check the connector carefully and refer to the information below for pictures and descriptions of connector identification markings. - Most of AFLs connectors have EPC on their connector body. Some of the smaller connectors will not have any markings on them. - In some cases Bosch will actually be printed on the connector. If Bosch does not appear on the connector, look for the Bosch logo. The Bosch logo is a circle with a blunted arrow inside. This logo can appear anywhere on the connector and is often very small. Page 8597 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link). - The wire insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. 5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold them between thumb and forefinger. 7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place. - Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction. - Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip. 8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool closes.Ensure that no strands of wire are cut. 10. Crimp the splice on each end (2). Page 1974 Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested: - Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. - Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a component or to other harnesses. - If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A TEST LAMP TOOLS REQUIRED J 35616-200 Test Light - Probe Kit NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminate even though voltage is present. The J 35616-200 is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair of leads. To properly operate this tool use the following procedures. When testing for voltage: 1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested. When testing for ground: 1. Attach one lead to battery positive voltage. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where ground should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is ground at the point being tested. Using Connector Test Adapters USING CONNECTOR TEST ADAPTERS NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Using Fused Jumper Wires USING FUSED JUMPER WIRES TOOLS REQUIRED J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged. The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested. AFL/ECP Connectors AFL/EPC CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 6712 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry one side of the nose piece up to the pre-stage position. When the nose piece is in the pre-staged position, the nose piece will be raised above the connector body the length of the step in the nose piece. 7. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry the other side of the piece to the pre-stage position. If the nose piece is higher than the first step in the nose piece, gently push down on the nose piece until it meets with resistance from the connector body, you should feel the nose piece click into position. Page 7657 MOLEX CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. 2. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. Page 3020 Oil Filter: Service and Repair Engine Oil and Oil Filter Replacement Removal Procedure Important: In order to completely drain the oil from the oil pan internal baffling, the bottom of the oil pan must be level during the oil drain procedure. 1. Open the hood. 2. Remove the oil fill cap. 3. Raise and suitably support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 4. Place a oil drain pan under the oil pan drain plug. 5. Remove the oil pan drain plug. 6. Drain the engine oil. 7. Remove the oil filter from the oil pan. 8. Inspect the old oil filter to ensure that the filter seal is not left on the oil pan. Page 5194 Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. FCI Connectors FCI CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 491 - JST connectors have JST in small letters on their connectors, similar to that above. The location of the logo will vary with the connector size and style. - Kostel has an "LK" with a circle around it. These connector are usually used as a transmissions connection and are currently use on some Cadillac vehicles. Page 4606 5. Insert the J 38125-557 (GM P/N 12122378) into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 6. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Connector Position Assurance Locks CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of the connector. CPAs are used in various connectors throughout the vehicle. CPAs are also used in all SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals, of the connector. Connector Repairs CONNECTOR REPAIRS Page 5492 11. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 12. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 13. Center the high temperature SCT1 shrink tube over the DuraSeal splice sleeve. 14. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the high temperature heat shrink tubing. 15. Gradually move the heat from the center to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 16. Replace any reflective tape and clips that may have been remove during the repair. Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation REPAIRING DAMAGED WIRE INSULATION Wire Size Conversion Page 4615 Depress the locks that are located on both sides of the wiredress cover and pull the lever over and past the locks. View of the connector when released from the component. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the front of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool push down on one of the locking tabs and pull the cover up until the dress cover releases. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. Page 4833 8. Insert the J 38125-213 into the small terminal release hole on the nose piece and gently pull on the back of the wire. 9. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Repairing Connector Terminals REPAIRING CONNECTOR TERMINALS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following: Push to Seat terminals - Pull to Seat terminals Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your terminal repair. The J-38125 contains further information. 1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.For cable seal terminals, remove the seal. 2. Apply the correct cable seal per gage size of the wire, if used.Slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation removal. 3. Remove the insulation. 4. For sealed terminals only, align the seal with the end of the cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal.For sealed terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal. 6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.For sealed terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable. 8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals excepting Micro-Pack 100.64 size. Soldering Micro-Pack 100 World terminals may damage the terminal. Sumitomo Connectors SUMITOMO CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 8374 Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Page 2331 6. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs located on the opposite side of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover at the connector end and pry up. 7. Remove the dress cover. 8. Cut the tie wrap on the wire bundle. 9. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting a small flat-bladed tool into the small slot in the end of the slider and pushing on the TPA until it comes out of the connector. When the TPA exits the opposite side of the connector, gasp the TPA and pull it completely out of the connector. 10. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 5379 Page 6447 pulling it through. This will prevent damage to the internal seals of the connector. Once the terminal is pushed out of the connector, cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible and pull the wire through the connector. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE The Micro-Pack 100W connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool was developed to crimp Micro-Pack 100W terminals. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 2. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert the terminal into the crimp tool until the core wings are flush with the anvil on the crimp tool. Be sure that the wings are pointed toward the crimp tool former and release the spring locator. The locator will hold the terminal in place. Inspect the alignment of the terminal wings with the crimp tool former. If the terminal wings are wider than the crimp tool former, remove the terminal and bend the terminal wings in slightly. 5. Place stripped wire into terminal. 6. Crimp the new terminal to the wire. If a jam occurs, press the emergency release to open applicator. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire perform the following procedure in order to replace Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. Page 1098 Traction Control Switch: Diagrams Antilock Brake System Connector End Views Traction Control Switch Traction Control Switch Page 4532 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 3283 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Kostal Connectors KOSTAL CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 6017 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Start in the middle and gradually move the heat barrel to the open ends of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Heated Oxygen Sensor Wiring Repairs HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being obstructed. If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. - Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks, etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire. - Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance. - To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector. Page 8906 difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Bosch Connectors (ECM) BOSCH CONNECTORS (ECM) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the assist lever on the top of the connector. Move the assist lever to the forward position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 4597 View of connector in released position. 4. Disconnect the connector from the component. 5. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Release the rear lower half of the wiredress cover. Page 7597 Page 2170 11. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 12. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 13. Center the high temperature SCT1 shrink tube over the DuraSeal splice sleeve. 14. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the high temperature heat shrink tubing. 15. Gradually move the heat from the center to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 16. Replace any reflective tape and clips that may have been remove during the repair. Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation REPAIRING DAMAGED WIRE INSULATION Wire Size Conversion Page 6189 MEASURING FREQUENCY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal. IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM to autorange to an appropriate range. 1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency measured. Measuring Voltage MEASURING VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit. 1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods: - Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. - Turn ON the engine. - Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls. - Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested. 3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The DMM displays the voltage measured at that point. Measuring Voltage Drop MEASURING VOLTAGE DROP NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points. Probing Electrical Connectors PROBING ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS Page 1571 It is very important to use the correct test adapter when testing for proper terminal contact of fuses and relays in a bussed electrical center (BEC). Use J-35616-35 to test for proper terminal contact. Failure to use J-35616-35 can result in improper diagnosis of the BEC. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Separate the connector halves. 2. Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body. 3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J-38125 , test that the retention force is significantly different between a good terminal and a suspect terminal. Replace the female terminal in question. FLAT WIRE (DOCK AND LOCK) CONNECTORS There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock) connectors on the harness side or the component side. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Remove the component in question. 2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side of the connector as oil from your skin may be a source of contamination as well. 3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other imperfections that could cause poor terminal contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are uniform and free of damage or deformation. 4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the on the flat wire harness connector in order to test the circuit in question. CONTROL MODULE/COMPONENT VOLTAGE AND GROUNDS Poor voltage or ground connections can cause widely varying symptoms. Test all control module voltage supply circuits. Many vehicles have multiple circuits supplying voltage to a control module. Other components in the system may have separate voltage supply circuits that may also need to be tested. Inspect connections at the module/component connectors, fuses, and any intermediate connections between the voltage source and the module/component. A test lamp or a DMM may indicate that voltage is present, but neither tests the ability of the circuit to carry sufficient current. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Power Distribution Schematics. - Test all control module ground and system ground circuits. The control module may have multiple ground circuits. Other components in the system may have separate grounds that may also need to be tested. Inspect grounds for clean and tight connections at the grounding point. Inspect the connections at the component and in splice packs, where applicable. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Ground Distribution Schematics. TEMPERATURE SENSITIVITY - An intermittent condition may occur when a component/connection reaches normal operating temperature. The condition may occur only when the component/connection is cold, or only when the component/connection is hot. - Freeze Frame, Failure Records, Snapshot, or Vehicle Data Recorder data may help with this type of intermittent condition, where applicable. - If the intermittent is related to heat, review the data for a relationship with the following: High ambient temperatures - Underhood/engine generated heat - Circuit generated heat due to a poor connection, or high electrical load - Higher than normal load conditions, towing, etc. - If the intermittent is related to cold, review the data for the following: Low ambient temperatures-In extremely low temperatures, ice may form in a connection or component. Inspect for water intrusion. - The condition only occurs on a cold start. - The condition goes away when the vehicle warms up. - Information from the customer may help to determine if the trouble follows a pattern that is temperature related. - If temperature is suspected of causing an intermittent fault condition, attempt to duplicate the condition. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required. ELECTROMAGNETIC INTERFERENCE (EMI) AND ELECTRICAL NOISE Some electrical components/circuits are sensitive to electromagnetic interference (EMI) or other types of electrical noise. Inspect for the following conditions: A misrouted harness that is too close to high voltage/high current devices such as secondary ignition components, motors, generator etc-These components may induce electrical noise on a circuit that could interfere with normal circuit operation. - Electrical system interference caused by a malfunctioning relay, or a control module driven solenoid or switch-These conditions can cause a sharp electrical surge. Normally, the condition will occur when the malfunctioning component is operating. - Improper installation of non-factory or aftermarket add on accessories such as lights, 2-way radios, amplifiers, electric motors, remote starters, alarm systems, cell phones, etc-These accessories may lead to interference while in use, but do not fail when the accessories are not in use. - Test for an open diode across the A/C compressor clutch and for other open diodes. Some relays may contain a clamping diode. - The generator may be allowing AC noise into the electrical system. INCORRECT CONTROL MODULE - There are only a few situations where reprogramming a control module is appropriate: A new service control module is installed. Page 271 Door Module: Connector Views Driver Door Module (DDM) C1 Page 2111 - Kostel - Molex - Sumitomo - Tyco/AMP - Yazaki Identifying the manufacturer of a connector is often difficult. When trying to determine the manufacturer of a connector, look for specific identifying marks that are unique to that connector supplier. Most of these identify marks are hard to find or see. Check the connector carefully and refer to the information below for pictures and descriptions of connector identification markings. - Most of AFLs connectors have EPC on their connector body. Some of the smaller connectors will not have any markings on them. - In some cases Bosch will actually be printed on the connector. If Bosch does not appear on the connector, look for the Bosch logo. The Bosch logo is a circle with a blunted arrow inside. This logo can appear anywhere on the connector and is often very small. Page 5929 Page 3691 2. Place the AT in Park (P) or the MT in the lowest gear (1st). 3. Securely attach the vehicle being towed to the tow vehicle. Caution: Shifting the transfer case to Neutral can cause the vehicle to roll, even if the transmission is in park (automatic) or 1st gear (manual), and may cause personal injury. 4. If equipped, place the transfer case shift lever in Neutral (N). Note: Use extra care whenever towing another vehicle. Do not exceed the towing vehicle's gross combination weight (GCW) by adding the weight of the dinghy towed vehicle or vehicle damage may result. 5. When the vehicle being towed is firmly attached to the tow vehicle, release the parking brake. 6. The Owner's Manual specifies the appropriate ignition key position to ensure that the steering is unlocked to allow the front wheels to follow the tow vehicle. Rear Wheel Drive Light Duty Trucks Important: ^ Dust or dirt can enter the back of the transmission through the opening created by the removal of the slip yoke from the transmission if proper protection is not provided. ^ Verify that the transmission fluid is at the proper level before driving the truck. Rear wheel drive vehicles, equipped with AT or MT, should NOT be dinghy towed. These transmissions have no provisions for internal lubrication while being towed. In order to properly tow these vehicles, place the vehicle on a platform trailer with all four tires off the ground. Avoid towing the vehicle with all four tires on the ground. In rare instances when it is unavoidable that a rear wheel drive vehicle be dinghy towed, the propeller shaft to axle yoke orientation should be marked and the propeller shaft removed. Refer to the applicable Service Manual for procedures on propeller shaft removal/installation. Transfer Case Identification Page 6711 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. 4. Remove the dress cover by using a flat bladed tool to release the dress cover locking tabs and lift up on the dress cover. 5. Cut the tie wrap that holds the wires to the connector body. Page 8133 3. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. View showing depressing of the lever lock release tab. Page 6660 IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals. Front probe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the connector. IMPORTANT: When probing female 0.64 terminals, it is important to use the correct adapter. There have been some revisions to the test adapter for 0.64 terminals. The proper adapter for 0.64 terminals is the J 35616-64B which has a gold terminal and a black wire between the base and tip. Failure to use the proper test adapter may result in damage to the terminal being tested and improper diagnosis. NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Page 4726 Heater Hose: Service and Repair Heater Outlet Hose Replacement (LH6) Heater Outlet Hose Replacement (LH6) Locations Oxygen Sensor: Locations Engine Controls Component Views Below Rear of the Engine 1 - Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Bank 2 Sensor 2 2 - Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Bank 2 Sensor 1 3 - Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Bank 1 Sensor 2 4 - Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Bank 1 Sensor 1 Page 4744 7. Install the inlet radiator hose to the radiator. 8. Reposition the inlet radiator hose clamp using J 38185. 9. Raise the vehicle. 10. Install the outlet radiator hose (1) to the radiator. 11. Reposition the outlet radiator hose clamp (1) using J 38185. 12. Connect the transmission cooler lines to the radiator. Refer to Transmission Fluid Cooler Hose/Pipe Quick-Connect Fitting Replacement for the 4L60-E/4L65-E transmission. 13. Install the lower radiator support shield, if equipped. Refer to Radiator Support Shield Replacement. 14. Lower the vehicle. 15. Fill the cooling system. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System (LL8) Draining and Filling Cooling System (LH6, LS2). Page 8865 6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias. Reference the appropriate service manual wiring schematic to obtain the correct diode installation position. 7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for the soldering equipment. 8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed. 9. IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode attachment points with tape. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape. Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable SPLICING TWISTED OR SHIELDED CABLE Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable. 1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splice is made. 3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire. Staggering the splices by 65 mm (2.5 in) is recommended. 4. IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical contact with the drain wire. Re-assemble the cable. Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape. - Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1). - Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire. - Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape. Locations Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Locations Engine Controls Component Views Upper Right Side of the Engine - Front 1 - Engine 2 - Engine Harness 3 - Air Duct 4 - Mass Air Flow (MAF)/Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor A/T - Key Will Not Release From Ignition Lock Cylinder Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Key Will Not Release From Ignition Lock Cylinder Bulletin No.: 05-07-30-021B Date: October 04, 2007 TECHNICAL Subject: Ignition Key Will Not Remove From Ignition Lock Cylinder (Reposition Shifter Boot) Models: 2004-2007 Buick Rainier 2002-2008 Chevrolet TrailBlazer Models 2002-2008 GMC Envoy Models 2003-2004 Oldsmobile Bravada Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to include the 2008 model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 05-07-30-021A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle). Condition Some customers may comment that they are unable to remove the ignition key from the ignition cylinder. Cause The shifter boot may be caught/trapped in the shifter assembly mechanism. Correction Inspect the shifter boot for being caught/trapped in the shifter assembly. If the shifter boot is NOT caught/trapped in the shift assembly, refer to Ignition Key Cannot Be Removed from the Ignition Lock Cylinder in SI. If the shifter boot IS caught/trapped in the shifter assembly, continue with the next step. DO NOT replace the complete shifter assembly for this condition. ONLY replace the shifter boot/handle if damaged by shifter assembly. Reposition the shifter boot so that it is not caught/trapped in the shifter assembly. Warranty Information Page 7789 TERMINAL REMOVAL Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors. 1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA) device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1). 3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 4. Gently pull the cable and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector. 5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal, refer to Terminal Repair. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3. Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector. REINSTALLING TERMINAL 1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly, refer to Wiring Repairs. 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3. Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) DELPHI CONNECTORS (WEATHER PACK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 8756 1. If reinstalling the old sensor, coat the threads with anti-seize compound GM P/N 12377953, or equivalent. Notice: Refer to Component Fastener Tightening Notice. 2. Install the HO2S (2). Tighten the sensor to 42 N.m (31 lb ft). 3. Connect the HO2S electrical connector. 4. Install the CPA retainer. 5. Lower the vehicle. Page 5173 Connector Anatomy Connector Repairs contains a list of all connector repairs. The connector repairs are listed by the connector manufacturer and then by connector type. If the technician cannot identify the manufacturer of the connector, refer to Identifying Connectors below. Knowing the connector manufacturer will assist in finding the correct connector repair from the following list: - Connector Position Assurance Locks - Terminal Position Assurance Locks - Bosch Connectors (0.64) Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) Bosch Connectors (BSK) Bosch Connectors (ECM) - Delphi Connectors (Micro.64) Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) Delphi Connectors (12-Way) - Tyco/AMP Connectors (CM 42-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) Tyco/AMP Connectors (025 Cap) Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) - Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) - Repairing Connector Terminals IDENTIFYING CONNECTORS Knowing the connector manufacturer is helpful when trying to locating the correct connector repair procedure. There are many different connector designs used on GM vehicles and it is sometimes difficult to identify the connector manufacturer. The information in this document should help with the identification of connector manufactures. The following connector manufacturers make most of the connectors found in GM vehicles: AFL/EPC (Alcoa Fujikura Ltd./Engineered Plastics Components) - Bosch - Delphi - FCI (Framatome Connectors International) - JAE (Japan Aviation Electronics) - JST (Japan Solderless Terminals) Page 760 The engine harness may be repaired using the J-38125. High Temperature Wiring Repairs HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperatures, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time may use materials i.e. wires, connectors, and shielding that has a higher heat rating than typical wiring. When making a repair in a high temperature area observe the following: Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature to replace any damaged wire. - Replace any heat shielding that is removed. - Cover any DuraSeal splice sleeves with SCT1 shrink tubing (available in the J-38125 Terminal Repair kit). - After making a wiring repair, ensure that the location of the wiring is not moved closer to the heat source. IDENTIFYING HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperature, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time need special considerations when making wiring repairs. Areas that may be exposed to higher temperatures can be identified by heat resistant materials that are being used in those areas. These materials may include heat reflective tape, moon tape, and high temperature shrink tubing. Also conduit and other protective coverings may be used. Because conduit or similar coverings are used throughout the vehicle regardless of the temperature, it may be necessary for the technician to determine if an area is exposed to excessive heat before making a wiring repair. Obvious areas of consideration would be any area located near the exhaust manifolds, catalytic converter, and exhaust pipes. The J-38125 contains much of the material you will need to perform repairs on areas exposed to high heat. The kit contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves to crimp and seal connections - High temperature SCT1 shrink tubing to protect the splice sleeves - A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct crimp tool to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools to remove the terminals from the connectors The J-38125 does not contain wire that is suitable to high temperature exposure. Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature of the same or larger gage size as the original wire when repair damage wire. Also replace any reflective tape that you remove during the repair. HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature rating of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125 and then encapsulate the splice sleeve using the high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the order listed. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip keeping all of the wire strands intact. Page 8120 Page 5149 Page 3751 7. Apply pressure and gently rock the cover until one locking leg is unseated. 8. Continue to apply pressure and rock the cover until the second locking leg is unseated. Repeat procedure for the other side of the dress cover and remove the cover. 9. Use J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) to gently lift the terminal retaining tab while gently pulling the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 10. If the terminal is severely bent or damaged, it may be possible on some connectors to push the wire out of the front of the connector instead of Page 5663 Checking Aftermarket Accessories CHECKING AFTERMARKET ACCESSORIES Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits: - CAUTION: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol. - NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice. OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol. Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the cause of the problems. Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include: Power feeds connected to points other than the battery - Antenna location - Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring - Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line - Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories. Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions INDUCING INTERMITTENT FAULT CONDITIONS TOOLS REQUIRED J 25070 Heat Gun Many intermittent open or shorted circuits are affected by harness/connector movement that is caused by vibration, engine torque, bumps/rough pavement, etc. In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness if the malfunction appears to be Heated Oxygen and Oxygen Sensor Notice Oxygen Sensor: Service Precautions Heated Oxygen and Oxygen Sensor Notice Heated Oxygen and Oxygen Sensor Notice Notice: Do not remove the pigtail from either the heated oxygen sensor (HO2S) or the oxygen sensor (O2S). Removing the pigtail or the connector will affect sensor operation. Handle the oxygen sensor carefully. Do not drop the HO2S. Keep the in-line electrical connector and the louvered end free of grease, dirt, or other contaminants. Do not use cleaning solvents of any type. Do not repair the wiring, connector or terminals. Replace the oxygen sensor if the pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged. This external clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors, or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degraded sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: * Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. * Do not damage the sensor pigtail and harness wires in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. * Ensure the sensor or vehicle lead wires are not bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends or kinks could block the reference air path through the lead wire. * Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire, where applicable. Vehicles that utilize the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will cause poor engine performance. * Ensure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector in order to prevent damage due to water intrusion. The engine harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air reference being obstructed. Page 3537 Frequently Asked Questions Disclaimer Page 5834 7. Apply pressure and gently rock the cover until one locking leg is unseated. 8. Continue to apply pressure and rock the cover until the second locking leg is unseated. Repeat procedure for the other side of the dress cover and remove the cover. 9. Use J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) to gently lift the terminal retaining tab while gently pulling the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 10. If the terminal is severely bent or damaged, it may be possible on some connectors to push the wire out of the front of the connector instead of Engine Controls - MIL ON/Misfire/Misfire DTC's Set Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL ON/Misfire/Misfire DTC's Set Bulletin No.: 06-06-04-046 Date: September 12, 2006 INFORMATION Subject: Information on Engine Misfire MIL/SES Light Illuminated or Flashing DTC P0300, P0301, P0302, P0303, P0304, P0305, P0306, P0307, P0308, P0420 or P0430 Models: 1999-2007 Cadillac, Chevrolet, GMC Full-Size Pickup and/or Utility Trucks with 4.8L, 5.3L, 5.7L, 6.0L or 6.2L VORTEC GEN III, GEN IV, V-8 Engine (VINs V, C, T, Z, B, 3, M, 0, J, R, U, N, Y, K, 8 - RPOs LR4, LY2, LM7, L59, L33, LC9, LH6, LMG, LY5, L31, LQ4, LQ9, L76, LY6, L92) with Active Fuel Management(TM) and E85 Flex Fuel If you encounter vehicles that exhibit the above conditions, refer to SI for the appropriate DTC(s) set. If no trouble is found, the cause may be due to an ECM ground terminal that has corroded with rust over time. Inspect the main engine wiring harness ground terminal (G103) for this condition. The wire terminal (G103) attaches either to the front or to the rear of the right side cylinder head, depending on the model year of the Full Size Pickup and/or Utility Trucks. If the ECM ground terminal has been found to be corroded, then follow the service procedure outlined in this bulletin to correct the corrosion issue. Remove either the nut or bolt securing the main engine wiring harness ground terminal (G103) to the right cylinder head. Refer to the above illustration to determine where the ground is located on the vehicle (1). Page 4902 difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Bosch Connectors (ECM) BOSCH CONNECTORS (ECM) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the assist lever on the top of the connector. Move the assist lever to the forward position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 2006 Release the lower wiredress cover locking tab. Release the upper wiredress cover locking tab. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. Page 1403 Page 1832 Page 6257 Release the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the blue locking tabs on both ends of the connector. Gently slide the TPA up to the released position on both ends. 6. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-13A (GM P/N 12031876-1) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. Page 4558 If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs SIR/SRS WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS, and the wiring components, such as connectors and terminals. IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system terminals. Use either an SIR/SRS pigtail or a terminated lead from the SIR Repair Kit Tray. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves, in order to repair the SIR/SRS wiring - A special crimping tool - A heat torch - An instruction manual The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides the necessary low resistance contact integrity for these sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors SIR/SRS CONNECTOR REPAIR (PLASTIC BODY AND TERMINAL METAL PIN) The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made with a special plating. This plating provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. Use the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit for repairing SIR/SRS terminals and connectors. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the repair kit. The J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit contains: Various terminated leads for sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) terminal replacement - Various connector positive assurance (CPA) locks for SIR/SRS connectors - Base of steering column pigtail connectors part number 12085514 - Yellow vinyl electrical tape Pigtail repair packs are available for SIR/SRS connectors with eight or less terminals. Only the connector body is available for connectors with more than eight terminals. The terminated leads in the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit can be used to replace damaged terminals when replacing the connector body. SIR/SRS COMPONENT WIRE PIGTAIL REPAIR IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails. A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device, not by a connector. If a wiring pigtail is damaged, you must replace the entire component, with pigtail. The inflatable restraint steering wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component. SIR/SRS WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Heater Inlet Hose Replacement (LH6) Heater Hose: Service and Repair Heater Inlet Hose Replacement (LH6) Heater Inlet Hose Replacement (LH6) Page 149 For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to refer to the table above. Disclaimer Page 8137 difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Bosch Connectors (ECM) BOSCH CONNECTORS (ECM) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the assist lever on the top of the connector. Move the assist lever to the forward position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 8707 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 7074 7. Pressing the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool in the release cavity of the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and crimper in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (DOOR MODULE) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Side view of connector. View of top of connector. 1. Locate the assist lever and lock on the top of the connector. Page 6413 MEASURING FREQUENCY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal. IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM to autorange to an appropriate range. 1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency measured. Measuring Voltage MEASURING VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit. 1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods: - Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. - Turn ON the engine. - Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls. - Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested. 3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The DMM displays the voltage measured at that point. Measuring Voltage Drop MEASURING VOLTAGE DROP NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points. Probing Electrical Connectors PROBING ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS Diagrams Oil Pressure Sender: Diagrams Displays and Gages Connector End Views Engine Oil Pressure (EOP) Sensor (5.3L/6.0L) Page 2167 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Start in the middle and gradually move the heat barrel to the open ends of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Heated Oxygen Sensor Wiring Repairs HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being obstructed. If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. - Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks, etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire. - Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance. - To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector. Page 5881 11. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 12. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 13. Center the high temperature SCT1 shrink tube over the DuraSeal splice sleeve. 14. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the high temperature heat shrink tubing. 15. Gradually move the heat from the center to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 16. Replace any reflective tape and clips that may have been remove during the repair. Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation REPAIRING DAMAGED WIRE INSULATION Wire Size Conversion Page 682 MEASURING FREQUENCY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal. IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM to autorange to an appropriate range. 1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency measured. Measuring Voltage MEASURING VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit. 1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods: - Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. - Turn ON the engine. - Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls. - Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested. 3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The DMM displays the voltage measured at that point. Measuring Voltage Drop MEASURING VOLTAGE DROP NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points. Probing Electrical Connectors PROBING ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS Page 5955 5. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove TPA from the connector. 6. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Page 6991 Body Control Module: Service and Repair Body Control Module Replacement BODY CONTROL MODULE REPLACEMENT REMOVAL PROCEDURE IMPORTANT: The ignition switch should be in the OFF position when connecting or disconnecting the connectors to the body control module (BCM). - Always disconnect the 40-way body wiring extension FIRST, the 32-way tan connector SECOND and the 24-way gray electrical connector LAST. - Always connect the 24-way gray electrical connector FIRST, the 32-way tan connector SECOND and the 40-way body wiring extension LAST. - The BCM can set DTCs with the ignition switch in the OFF position. The BCM has battery run down protection for the courtesy lamp circuit. The BCM battery run down protection cannot detect shorts on inputs or other circuits which the BCM does not control. Use the scan tool in order to activate the POWER DOWN NOW mode. Use the POWER DOWN NOW mode in order to check for current draws on circuits that are not controlled by the BCM, or controlled by the battery run down protection system. - Do not touch the exposed electrical contacts of the body wiring extension. Do not open the BCM housing. The module does not have any serviceable components. The module may be replaced only as an assembly. 1. CAUTION: Refer to Battery Disconnect Caution. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. If replacing the BCM on a Chevrolet TrailBlazer EXT or GMC Envoy XL, remove the left second row seat. 3. If replacing the BCM on a Chevrolet TrailBlazer or GMC Envoy, position the left hand second seat to a cargo position. 4. Remove the rear electrical center cover. 5. Press down and hold the locking tab (1). 6. Disengage the sliding latch retaining the BCM to the rear electrical center.Slide the latch inboard until fully extended, approximately 40 mm (1.6 in). 7. Disconnect the 40-way body wiring extension (1) from the BCM. Page 5182 4. Once the front 2 locks are unlocked, lift the front of the dress cover and pull it forward. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the small slot on the TPA and pushing down until the TPA releases. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to angle or rock the J 38125-21 tool when inserting it into the connector or the tool may break. Insert the J 38125-21 (GM P/N 15381651-2) tool into the round canal between the terminals cavities at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to repair Micro 64 connector terminals. The Micro 64 connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-64 (M jaw) was developed to crimp Micro 64 terminals. The J 38125-64 crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. The J 38125-64 crimping tool is also designed to crimp both the wire and the insulation at the same time. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro 64 terminals. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. 1. Cut the wire as close to the damaged terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. Page 8823 2. Locate the two indents of the terminal position assurance (TPA) located on the bottom of the connector body. Page 4374 - A control module from another vehicle is installed. - Revised software/calibration files have been released for this vehicle. - IMPORTANT: DO NOT re-program the control module with the SAME software/calibration files that are already present in the control module. This is not an effective repair for any type of concern. Verify that the control module contains the correct software/calibration. If incorrect programming is found, reprogram the control module with the most current software/calibration. Refer to Control Module References for replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Testing for Short to Ground TESTING FOR SHORT TO GROUND NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 4. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit. With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is a short to ground in the circuit. Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2. Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). - When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. - If the DMM does not display voltage 4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is shorted. Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A DIGITAL MULTIMETER NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the powertrain control module (PCM), should only be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200 Digital Multimeter (DMM). The J 39200 instruction manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminage even though voltage is present. The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity. IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading. Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the measurement. Page 2614 8. Insert the J 38125-213 into the small terminal release hole on the nose piece and gently pull on the back of the wire. 9. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Repairing Connector Terminals REPAIRING CONNECTOR TERMINALS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following: Push to Seat terminals - Pull to Seat terminals Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your terminal repair. The J-38125 contains further information. 1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.For cable seal terminals, remove the seal. 2. Apply the correct cable seal per gage size of the wire, if used.Slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation removal. 3. Remove the insulation. 4. For sealed terminals only, align the seal with the end of the cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal.For sealed terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal. 6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.For sealed terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable. 8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals excepting Micro-Pack 100.64 size. Soldering Micro-Pack 100 World terminals may damage the terminal. Sumitomo Connectors SUMITOMO CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 5931 Page 4391 - JST connectors have JST in small letters on their connectors, similar to that above. The location of the logo will vary with the connector size and style. - Kostel has an "LK" with a circle around it. These connector are usually used as a transmissions connection and are currently use on some Cadillac vehicles. Page 4829 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the rear TPA from the connector. 7. IMPORTANT: The front TPA cannot be removed from the connector. Only move it to the release point. Use a small flat-blade tool to move the front TPA to the release position. 8. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 9. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Molex Connectors Page 6934 7. The illustration above identifies the entry canal where the terminal release tool will be inserted, and the terminal cavity. - Terminal (1) - Entry Canal (2) 8. Insert the J-38125-553 (15315247) tool into the entry canal and pry up on the terminal retainer. The terminal retainer is a small plastic piece on the top of the terminal. The terminal retainer must be held up while the terminal is pulled out of the connector. Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 04-06-04-054B Date: November 18, 2010 Subject: Info - Non-GM Parts and Accessories (Aftermarket) Models: 2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years and update to the new U.S. Fixed Operation Manager (FOM) and Canada Warranty Manager (WM) names. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 04-06-04-054A (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). The recent rise and expansion of companies selling non-GM parts and accessories has made it necessary to issue this reminder to dealers regarding GM's policy on the use and installation of these aftermarket components. When a dealer is performing a repair under the New Vehicle Limited Warranty, they are required to use only genuine GM or GM-approved parts and accessories. This applies to all warranty repairs, special policy repairs or any repairs paid for by GM. Parts and accessories advertised as being "the same" as parts manufactured by GM, but not sold through GM, do not qualify for use in warranty repairs, special policy repairs or any repairs paid for by GM. During a warranty repair, if a GM original equipment part is not available through GM Customer Care and Aftersales (GM CC&A;), ACDelco(R) distributors, other GM dealers or approved sources, the dealer is to obtain comparable, non-GM parts and clearly indicate, in detail, on the repair order the circumstances surrounding why non-GM parts were used. The dealer must give customers written notice, prior to the sale or service, that such parts or accessories are not marketed or warranted by General Motors. It should also be noted that dealers modifying new vehicles and installing equipment, parts and accessories obtained from sources not authorized by GM are responsible for complying with the National Traffic and Motor Vehicle Safety Act. Certain non-approved parts or assemblies, installed by the dealer or its agent not authorized by GM, may result in a change to the vehicle's design characteristics and may affect the vehicle's ability to conform to federal law. Dealers must fully understand that non-GM approved parts may not have been validated, tested or certified for use. This puts the dealer at risk for potential liability in the event of a part or vehicle failure. If a GM part failure occurs as the result of the installation or use of a non-GM approved part, the warranty will not be honored. A good example of non-authorized modification of vehicles is the result of an ever increasing supply of aftermarket devices available to the customer, which claim to increase the horsepower and torque of the Duramax(TM) Diesel Engines. These include the addition of, but are not limited to one or more of the following modifications: - Propane injection - Nitrous oxide injection - Additional modules (black boxes) that connect to the vehicle wiring systems - Revised engine calibrations downloaded for the engine control module - Calibration modules which connect to the vehicle diagnostic connector - Modification to the engine turbocharger waste gate Although the installation of these devices, or modification of vehicle components, can increase engine horsepower and torque, they may also negatively affect the engine emissions, reliability and/or durability. In addition, other powertrain components, such as transmissions, universal joints, drive shafts, and front/rear axle components, can be stressed beyond design safety limits by the installation of these devices. General Motors does not support or endorse the use of devices or modifications that, when installed, increase the engine horsepower and torque. It is because of these unknown stresses, and the potential to alter reliability, durability and emissions performance, that GM has adopted a policy that prevents any UNAUTHORIZED dealer warranty claim submissions to any remaining warranty coverage, to the powertrain and driveline components whenever the presence of a non-GM (aftermarket) calibration is confirmed - even if the non-GM control module calibration is subsequently removed. Refer to the latest version of Bulletin 09-06-04-026 (V8 Gas Engines) or 06-06-01-007 (Duramax(TM) Diesel Engines) for more information on dealer requirements for calibration verification. These same policies apply as they relate to the use of non-GM accessories. Damage or failure from the use or installation of a non-GM accessory will not be covered under warranty. Failure resulting from the alteration or modification of the vehicle, including the cutting, welding or disconnecting of the vehicle's original equipment parts and components will void the warranty. Additionally, dealers will NOT be reimbursed or compensated by GM in the event of any legal inquiry at either the local, state or federal level that Page 8392 5. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove TPA from the connector. 6. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Page 4414 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully raise the TPA on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA cannot be removed from the connector while there are terminals present in the connector body. View of the TPA when removed from the connector body. 4. Use the J 38125-12A tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the left side of the terminal release cavity as shown in the graphic. Use the tool to move the terminal release to the right with a gentle prying motion. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Diagrams Oil Pressure Sender: Diagrams Displays and Gages Connector End Views Engine Oil Pressure (EOP) Sensor (5.3L/6.0L) Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview Information Bus: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview DIAGNOSTIC STARTING POINT - DATA COMMUNICATIONS Begin the system diagnosis with Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle. The Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle will provide the following information: - The identification of the control modules which are not communicating. - The identification of any stored diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) and their status. The use of the Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle will identify the correct procedures to begin vehicle diagnosis. These must be performed before system DTC or symptom diagnosis. Page 186 Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested: - Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. - Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a component or to other harnesses. - If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A TEST LAMP TOOLS REQUIRED J 35616-200 Test Light - Probe Kit NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminate even though voltage is present. The J 35616-200 is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair of leads. To properly operate this tool use the following procedures. When testing for voltage: 1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested. When testing for ground: 1. Attach one lead to battery positive voltage. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where ground should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is ground at the point being tested. Using Connector Test Adapters USING CONNECTOR TEST ADAPTERS NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Using Fused Jumper Wires USING FUSED JUMPER WIRES TOOLS REQUIRED J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged. The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested. AFL/ECP Connectors AFL/EPC CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 6379 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Start in the middle and gradually move the heat barrel to the open ends of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Heated Oxygen Sensor Wiring Repairs HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being obstructed. If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. - Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks, etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire. - Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance. - To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector. Page 2350 TERMINAL REMOVAL Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors. 1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA) device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1). 3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 4. Gently pull the cable and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector. 5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal, refer to Terminal Repair. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3. Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector. REINSTALLING TERMINAL 1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly, refer to Wiring Repairs. 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3. Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) DELPHI CONNECTORS (WEATHER PACK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 7206 8. Insert the J 38125-213 into the small terminal release hole on the nose piece and gently pull on the back of the wire. 9. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Repairing Connector Terminals REPAIRING CONNECTOR TERMINALS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following: Push to Seat terminals - Pull to Seat terminals Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your terminal repair. The J-38125 contains further information. 1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.For cable seal terminals, remove the seal. 2. Apply the correct cable seal per gage size of the wire, if used.Slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation removal. 3. Remove the insulation. 4. For sealed terminals only, align the seal with the end of the cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal.For sealed terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal. 6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.For sealed terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable. 8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals excepting Micro-Pack 100.64 size. Soldering Micro-Pack 100 World terminals may damage the terminal. Sumitomo Connectors SUMITOMO CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 3762 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. JST Connectors JST CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, remove the connector from the component. Page 1890 4. Slide the dress cover forward and off of the connector. 5. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front and rear of the connector. Page 8143 5. Insert the J 38125-557 (GM P/N 12122378) into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 6. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Connector Position Assurance Locks CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of the connector. CPAs are used in various connectors throughout the vehicle. CPAs are also used in all SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals, of the connector. Connector Repairs CONNECTOR REPAIRS Page 8726 breakers are used. CIRCUIT BREAKER This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high current is removed. POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) CIRCUIT BREAKER This type greatly increases its resistance when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker will re-close within a second or 2. Circuit Protection - Fuses CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSES The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and examine the element in the fuse for an open (2). If not broken (1), also check for continuity using a DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one of equal current rating. Circuit Protection - Fusible Links CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSIBLE LINKS Page 8539 View of a typical Micro 64 connector. Depress the lock and pull the lever over and past the lock. Page 5535 3. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. View showing depressing of the lever lock release tab. Page 5607 If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs SIR/SRS WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS, and the wiring components, such as connectors and terminals. IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system terminals. Use either an SIR/SRS pigtail or a terminated lead from the SIR Repair Kit Tray. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves, in order to repair the SIR/SRS wiring - A special crimping tool - A heat torch - An instruction manual The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides the necessary low resistance contact integrity for these sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors SIR/SRS CONNECTOR REPAIR (PLASTIC BODY AND TERMINAL METAL PIN) The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made with a special plating. This plating provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. Use the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit for repairing SIR/SRS terminals and connectors. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the repair kit. The J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit contains: Various terminated leads for sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) terminal replacement - Various connector positive assurance (CPA) locks for SIR/SRS connectors - Base of steering column pigtail connectors part number 12085514 - Yellow vinyl electrical tape Pigtail repair packs are available for SIR/SRS connectors with eight or less terminals. Only the connector body is available for connectors with more than eight terminals. The terminated leads in the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit can be used to replace damaged terminals when replacing the connector body. SIR/SRS COMPONENT WIRE PIGTAIL REPAIR IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails. A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device, not by a connector. If a wiring pigtail is damaged, you must replace the entire component, with pigtail. The inflatable restraint steering wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component. SIR/SRS WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 6478 3. Ensure that the terminal release tang access panel is in the correct location to access the terminals. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) into the terminal release tang access slot located behind the access panel of the connector and press down on the terminal while carefully pulling the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Tyco/AMP Connectors (0.25 Cap) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (025 CAP) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component by pressing down on the connector position assurance (CPA). Page 4660 View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. 4. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers CIRCUIT PROTECTION - CIRCUIT BREAKERS A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types of circuit Page 3253 6. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs located on the opposite side of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover at the connector end and pry up. 7. Remove the dress cover. 8. Cut the tie wrap on the wire bundle. 9. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting a small flat-bladed tool into the small slot in the end of the slider and pushing on the TPA until it comes out of the connector. When the TPA exits the opposite side of the connector, gasp the TPA and pull it completely out of the connector. 10. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 1620 8. Insert the J 38125-213 into the small terminal release hole on the nose piece and gently pull on the back of the wire. 9. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Repairing Connector Terminals REPAIRING CONNECTOR TERMINALS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following: Push to Seat terminals - Pull to Seat terminals Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your terminal repair. The J-38125 contains further information. 1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.For cable seal terminals, remove the seal. 2. Apply the correct cable seal per gage size of the wire, if used.Slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation removal. 3. Remove the insulation. 4. For sealed terminals only, align the seal with the end of the cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal.For sealed terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal. 6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.For sealed terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable. 8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals excepting Micro-Pack 100.64 size. Soldering Micro-Pack 100 World terminals may damage the terminal. Sumitomo Connectors SUMITOMO CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 2610 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the rear TPA from the connector. 7. IMPORTANT: The front TPA cannot be removed from the connector. Only move it to the release point. Use a small flat-blade tool to move the front TPA to the release position. 8. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 9. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Molex Connectors Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules Relay Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 09-06-03-004D Date: December 08, 2010 Subject: Intermittent No Crank/No Start, No Module Communication, MIL, Warning Lights, Vehicle Messages or DTCs Set by Various Control Modules - Diagnosing and Repairing Fretting Corrosion (Disconnect Affected Connector and Apply Dielectric Lubricant) Models: 2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks Attention: This repair can be applied to ANY electrical connection including, but not limited to: lighting, body electrical, in-line connections, powertrain control sensors, etc. DO NOT over apply lubricant to the point where it prevents the full engagement of sealed connectors. A light coating on the terminal surfaces is sufficient to correct the condition. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the Attention statement and add the 2011 model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 09-06-03-004C (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System). Condition Some customers may comment on any of the following conditions: - An intermittent no crank/no start - Intermittent malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) illumination - Intermittent service lamp illumination - Intermittent service message(s) being displayed The technician may determine that he is unable to duplicate the intermittent condition. Cause This condition may be caused by a buildup of nonconductive insulating oxidized debris known as fretting corrosion, occurring between two electrical contact surfaces of the connection or connector. This may be caused by any of the following conditions: - Vibration - Thermal cycling - Poor connection/terminal retention - Micro motion - A connector, component or wiring harness not properly secured resulting in movement On low current signal circuits this condition may cause high resistance, resulting in intermittent connections. On high current power circuits this condition may cause permanent increases in the resistance and may cause a device to become inoperative. Representative List of Control Modules and Components The following is only a representative list of control modules and components that may be affected by this connection or connector condition and DOES NOT include every possible module or component for every vehicle. - Blower Control Module - Body Control Module (BCM) - Communication Interface Module (CIM) - Cooling Fan Control Module - Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM) - Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module (EBTCM) - Electronic Suspension Control (ESC) Module - Engine Control Module (ECM) - Heating, Ventilation and Air Conditioning (HVAC) Control Module Page 2860 1. Place hands on the rear bumper and jounce the rear of the vehicle. Make sure that there is at least 38 mm (1.5 in) of movement while jouncing. 2. Allow the vehicle to settle into position. Important: A D-height block can be used to determine the D-height position. Create a D-height measurement gage, using metal stock. Cut a block to 20 mm (0.79 in) X 30 mm (1.81 in) X the correct D trim height specification. For the correct D height specification, refer to Trim Height Specifications. 3. Measure the D height by measuring vertical distance (2) between the top surface of the axle and to the side of the hole, center on the jounce bumper reinforcement bracket. 4. Repeat the jouncing operation and measurement 2 more times for a total of 3 times. 5. Use the highest and lowest measurements to calculate the average height. 6. The true D height dimension is the average of the highest and lowest measurements. Refer to Trim Height Specifications. 7. If these measurements are out of specifications, inspect for the following conditions: ^ Sagging rear suspension-Refer to Coil Spring Replacement or Air Spring Replacement. ^ Collision damage Page 3227 Page 9072 6. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by pressing on the tang. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (SENSOR) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) tool into the cavity on the lower right hand face of the connector until the terminal release tang access panel slides over. Page 1505 The engine harness may be repaired using the J-38125. High Temperature Wiring Repairs HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperatures, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time may use materials i.e. wires, connectors, and shielding that has a higher heat rating than typical wiring. When making a repair in a high temperature area observe the following: Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature to replace any damaged wire. - Replace any heat shielding that is removed. - Cover any DuraSeal splice sleeves with SCT1 shrink tubing (available in the J-38125 Terminal Repair kit). - After making a wiring repair, ensure that the location of the wiring is not moved closer to the heat source. IDENTIFYING HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperature, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time need special considerations when making wiring repairs. Areas that may be exposed to higher temperatures can be identified by heat resistant materials that are being used in those areas. These materials may include heat reflective tape, moon tape, and high temperature shrink tubing. Also conduit and other protective coverings may be used. Because conduit or similar coverings are used throughout the vehicle regardless of the temperature, it may be necessary for the technician to determine if an area is exposed to excessive heat before making a wiring repair. Obvious areas of consideration would be any area located near the exhaust manifolds, catalytic converter, and exhaust pipes. The J-38125 contains much of the material you will need to perform repairs on areas exposed to high heat. The kit contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves to crimp and seal connections - High temperature SCT1 shrink tubing to protect the splice sleeves - A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct crimp tool to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools to remove the terminals from the connectors The J-38125 does not contain wire that is suitable to high temperature exposure. Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature of the same or larger gage size as the original wire when repair damage wire. Also replace any reflective tape that you remove during the repair. HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature rating of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125 and then encapsulate the splice sleeve using the high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the order listed. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip keeping all of the wire strands intact. Page 8952 9. The illustration shows a cutaway view of the connector to aid the technician in releasing the terminal retainer. 10. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Terminal Position Assurance Locks TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Tyco/Amp Connectors (CM 42-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (CM 42-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the connector body and pull the CPA out. The CPA is on the wire harness side of connector. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 1267 steering column. 10. Depress the horn contacts in the steering wheel. Does the horn work? ^ Yes - Check if the operation of the horn is sensitive to pressure applied to the steering wheel as if a driver were doing a panic stop. In some cases, pressure applied to the steering wheel in different directions will expose a bad ground path in the steering column. Proceed to step 11. ^ No - proceed with step 11. 11. Inspect the steering column through the insulator panel location. Note: The shaft from the steering wheel comes through a metal bracket. That bracket is surrounded by plastic, which is inside of another metal bracket. Look for a small metal clip (refer to the "horn clip" graphic) that connects the inner bracket (inside the plastic) and the outer bracket. This clip provides an auxiliary ground path which is needed in some cases, if the primary path has a bad connection. 12. To verify this, connect a test light between the red wire on the horn contacts in the steering wheel and the steering column sections (1) and (2) in the illustration. Does the horn work when grounded to (1) and not (2)? ^ Yes - add or replace the horn clip. ^ No - refer to the Horn Inoperative section in SI to diagnose which component in the circuit is causing the horn inoperative condition. Parts Information Warranty Information Disclaimer Page 5338 4. Slide the dress cover forward and off of the connector. 5. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front and rear of the connector. Page 2548 Page 7717 1. Install the MAP sensor (1). Push the MAP sensor into the intake manifold. 2. Install the MAP sensor retainer (2) to the intake manifold. 3. Connect the MAP sensor electrical connector (3). Page 6725 2. Use a small flat-bladed tool to release the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting the tool in the small recess on the side of the connector and pushing up until the TPA releases from the connector body. The TPA should raise just slightly. Do not try to remove the TPA. IMPORTANT: The TPA on this connector cannot be removed unless the terminals are removed first. The TPA will come out of the connector body, but only slightly. When the TPA is slightly raised the terminals can be removed. Using excessive force to remove the TPA with the terminals still in the connector will damage the connector. 3. Repeat the process for the other side of the connector. 4. Ensure that the TPA is in the proper position to remove the terminals. Page 3442 US English/Metric Conversion US English/Metric Conversion Page 1636 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert a small flat-blade tool in the slot below the front loaded terminal position assurance (TPA) and pry up. 3. Remove the TPA by pulling it out of the connector. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-553 (GM P/N 15315247) on a slight upward angle into the cavity below the terminal to be removed. Ensure that the pointed on the end of the tool is facing the bottom of the terminal and it stays in contact with the terminal until it stops on the plastic terminal retainer. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 4650 4. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the rear of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. 5. Once the locking tabs are unlocked, slide the inner connector out of the rear of the connector housing. Page 1630 6. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by pressing on the tang. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (SENSOR) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) tool into the cavity on the lower right hand face of the connector until the terminal release tang access panel slides over. Engine/Transmission - Aftermarket Calibrations Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine/Transmission - Aftermarket Calibrations INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 09-06-04-026B Date: April 07, 2010 Subject: Identifying Non-GM (Aftermarket) Engine and Transmission Calibrations for V8 Gas Engines Using Tech 2(R) or Global Diagnostic System (GDS) Models: 2006-2010 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Excluding Saab 9-7X) 2006-2009 HUMMER H2 2006-2010 HUMMER H3 Equipped with V8 Gas Powered Engines Only Attention: This bulletin applies to V8 gas powered engines ONLY. For Duramax(TM) diesel powered engines, refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 08-06-04-006G. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2010 model year and information about retrieving calibrations on a Global A vehicle. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 09-06-04-026A (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). General Motors is identifying an increasing number of engine, transmission and catalytic converter part failures that are the result of non-GM (aftermarket) engine and transmission control calibrations being used. When alteration to the GM-released engine or transmission control calibrations occurs, it subjects powertrain and driveline components (engine, transmission, transfer case, driveshaft and rear axle) to stresses that were not tested by General Motors. It is because of these unknown stresses, and the potential to alter reliability, durability and emissions performance, that GM has adopted a policy that prevents any UNAUTHORIZED dealer warranty claim submissions to any remaining warranty coverage, to the powertrain and driveline components whenever the presence of a non-GM (aftermarket) calibration is confirmed - even if the non-GM control module calibration is subsequently removed. Warranty coverage is based on the equipment and calibrations that were released on the vehicle at time of sale, or subsequently updated by GM. That's because GM testing and validation matches the calibration to a host of criteria that is essential to assure reliability, durability and emissions performance over the life of the warranty coverage and beyond. Stresses resulting from calibrations different from those tested and released by GM can damage or weaken components, leading to poor performance and or shortened life. Additionally, non-GM (aftermarket) issued engine control modifications often do not meet the same emissions performance standards as GM issued calibrations. Depending on state statutes, individuals who install engine control module calibrations that put the vehicle outside the parameters of emissions certification standards may be subject to fines and/or penalties. This bulletin outlines a procedure to identify the presence of non-GM (aftermarket) calibrations. GM recommends performing this check whenever a hard part failure is seen on internal engine or transmission components, or before an engine assembly or transmission assembly is being replaced under warranty. It is also recommended that the engine calibration verification procedure be performed whenever diagnostics indicate that catalytic converter replacement is indicated. The PQC has a process to confirm the ECM/PCM calibration is GM issued. The PQC will require a picture of the engine calibration verification screen, as outlined in this bulletin, before authorizing any V8 gas powered engine replacement. If a non-GM calibration is found and verification has taken place through GM, the remaining powertrain and driveline warranty will be blocked and notated in GMVIS and the dealership will be notified. This block prevents any UNAUTHORIZED warranty claim submission. 1. Connect the Tech 2(R) to the vehicle. 2. Go to: Diagnostics and build the vehicle. 3. Select: Powertrain. 4. Select: Engine. 5. *Select: Engine Control Module or PCM. 6. *Select: Module ID Information or I/M Information System if the Module ID Information selection is not available. 7. *If "I/M information System" was selected, it may be necessary to select "Vehicle Information" in order to display the calibration information. ‹› If the CVN information is displayed as "N/A", it will be necessary to contact the TCSC to obtain the CVN information. Page 7477 to analyze the data during the time a vehicle condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a trigger point that you have determined. Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2 snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a first-in, first-out basis. If a third snapshot is taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost. Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types: Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice - Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200 frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not lost if the Scan Tool is powered down. The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis. The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected values by plotting 3 parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful, especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC. Testing for a Short to Voltage TESTING FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4. Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt, there is a short to voltage in the circuit. Testing for Continuity TESTING FOR CONTINUITY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6. Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit. 7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity. With a Test Lamp IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits. 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6. If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity. Testing for Electrical Intermittents TESTING FOR ELECTRICAL INTERMITTENTS Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment. - Testing for Short to Ground - Testing for Continuity - Testing for a Short to Voltage Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules Relay Module: Customer Interest Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 09-06-03-004D Date: December 08, 2010 Subject: Intermittent No Crank/No Start, No Module Communication, MIL, Warning Lights, Vehicle Messages or DTCs Set by Various Control Modules - Diagnosing and Repairing Fretting Corrosion (Disconnect Affected Connector and Apply Dielectric Lubricant) Models: 2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks Attention: This repair can be applied to ANY electrical connection including, but not limited to: lighting, body electrical, in-line connections, powertrain control sensors, etc. DO NOT over apply lubricant to the point where it prevents the full engagement of sealed connectors. A light coating on the terminal surfaces is sufficient to correct the condition. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the Attention statement and add the 2011 model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 09-06-03-004C (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System). Condition Some customers may comment on any of the following conditions: - An intermittent no crank/no start - Intermittent malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) illumination - Intermittent service lamp illumination - Intermittent service message(s) being displayed The technician may determine that he is unable to duplicate the intermittent condition. Cause This condition may be caused by a buildup of nonconductive insulating oxidized debris known as fretting corrosion, occurring between two electrical contact surfaces of the connection or connector. This may be caused by any of the following conditions: - Vibration - Thermal cycling - Poor connection/terminal retention - Micro motion - A connector, component or wiring harness not properly secured resulting in movement On low current signal circuits this condition may cause high resistance, resulting in intermittent connections. On high current power circuits this condition may cause permanent increases in the resistance and may cause a device to become inoperative. Representative List of Control Modules and Components The following is only a representative list of control modules and components that may be affected by this connection or connector condition and DOES NOT include every possible module or component for every vehicle. - Blower Control Module - Body Control Module (BCM) - Communication Interface Module (CIM) - Cooling Fan Control Module - Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM) - Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module (EBTCM) - Electronic Suspension Control (ESC) Module - Engine Control Module (ECM) - Heating, Ventilation and Air Conditioning (HVAC) Control Module Page 8904 Release the tabs that are holding the wiredress cover to the connector body. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the slots on both ends of the connector body. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. J 38125-216 can also be used to remove the nose piece. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by lifting the terminal retaining tabs on the inside of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 8969 If a wire is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm, etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except coaxial. - Do not use the DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent American wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Specifications Ignition Cable: Specifications Spark Plug Wire Resistance................................................................................................................. ...........................................................397-1,337 ohms Page 5309 Connector Anatomy Connector Repairs contains a list of all connector repairs. The connector repairs are listed by the connector manufacturer and then by connector type. If the technician cannot identify the manufacturer of the connector, refer to Identifying Connectors below. Knowing the connector manufacturer will assist in finding the correct connector repair from the following list: - Connector Position Assurance Locks - Terminal Position Assurance Locks - Bosch Connectors (0.64) Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) Bosch Connectors (BSK) Bosch Connectors (ECM) - Delphi Connectors (Micro.64) Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) Delphi Connectors (12-Way) - Tyco/AMP Connectors (CM 42-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) Tyco/AMP Connectors (025 Cap) Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) - Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) - Repairing Connector Terminals IDENTIFYING CONNECTORS Knowing the connector manufacturer is helpful when trying to locating the correct connector repair procedure. There are many different connector designs used on GM vehicles and it is sometimes difficult to identify the connector manufacturer. The information in this document should help with the identification of connector manufactures. The following connector manufacturers make most of the connectors found in GM vehicles: AFL/EPC (Alcoa Fujikura Ltd./Engineered Plastics Components) - Bosch - Delphi - FCI (Framatome Connectors International) - JAE (Japan Aviation Electronics) - JST (Japan Solderless Terminals) Page 6227 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) and slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. Page 8744 Oxygen Sensor: Connector Views Engine Controls Connector End Views Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Bank 1 Sensor 1 Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Bank 1 Sensor 2 Page 5468 3. Remove the dress cover by using a flat-blade tool to release the connector locking tabs and pulling off the dress cover. 4. Relieve the tension on the nose piece retainers by inserting J-38125-12A (12094429) into the single retainer slot on the end of the nose piece and gently prying out the locking tab. Repeat the process for both of the nose piece locking tabs on the opposite side of the nose piece. Page 2225 - In some cases Delphi will actually be printed on the connector. If Delphi is not printed on the connector, look for PED. In both cases there is no specific orientation for Delphi or PED and they can appear anywhere on the connector. - FCI connectors may have the FCI logo on their connectors. The logo is the letters FCI with an "A" above it. - JAE connector have JAE in small letters on their connectors. Page 7157 It is very important to use the correct test adapter when testing for proper terminal contact of fuses and relays in a bussed electrical center (BEC). Use J-35616-35 to test for proper terminal contact. Failure to use J-35616-35 can result in improper diagnosis of the BEC. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Separate the connector halves. 2. Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body. 3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J-38125 , test that the retention force is significantly different between a good terminal and a suspect terminal. Replace the female terminal in question. FLAT WIRE (DOCK AND LOCK) CONNECTORS There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock) connectors on the harness side or the component side. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Remove the component in question. 2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side of the connector as oil from your skin may be a source of contamination as well. 3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other imperfections that could cause poor terminal contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are uniform and free of damage or deformation. 4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the on the flat wire harness connector in order to test the circuit in question. CONTROL MODULE/COMPONENT VOLTAGE AND GROUNDS Poor voltage or ground connections can cause widely varying symptoms. Test all control module voltage supply circuits. Many vehicles have multiple circuits supplying voltage to a control module. Other components in the system may have separate voltage supply circuits that may also need to be tested. Inspect connections at the module/component connectors, fuses, and any intermediate connections between the voltage source and the module/component. A test lamp or a DMM may indicate that voltage is present, but neither tests the ability of the circuit to carry sufficient current. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Power Distribution Schematics. - Test all control module ground and system ground circuits. The control module may have multiple ground circuits. Other components in the system may have separate grounds that may also need to be tested. Inspect grounds for clean and tight connections at the grounding point. Inspect the connections at the component and in splice packs, where applicable. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Ground Distribution Schematics. TEMPERATURE SENSITIVITY - An intermittent condition may occur when a component/connection reaches normal operating temperature. The condition may occur only when the component/connection is cold, or only when the component/connection is hot. - Freeze Frame, Failure Records, Snapshot, or Vehicle Data Recorder data may help with this type of intermittent condition, where applicable. - If the intermittent is related to heat, review the data for a relationship with the following: High ambient temperatures - Underhood/engine generated heat - Circuit generated heat due to a poor connection, or high electrical load - Higher than normal load conditions, towing, etc. - If the intermittent is related to cold, review the data for the following: Low ambient temperatures-In extremely low temperatures, ice may form in a connection or component. Inspect for water intrusion. - The condition only occurs on a cold start. - The condition goes away when the vehicle warms up. - Information from the customer may help to determine if the trouble follows a pattern that is temperature related. - If temperature is suspected of causing an intermittent fault condition, attempt to duplicate the condition. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required. ELECTROMAGNETIC INTERFERENCE (EMI) AND ELECTRICAL NOISE Some electrical components/circuits are sensitive to electromagnetic interference (EMI) or other types of electrical noise. Inspect for the following conditions: A misrouted harness that is too close to high voltage/high current devices such as secondary ignition components, motors, generator etc-These components may induce electrical noise on a circuit that could interfere with normal circuit operation. - Electrical system interference caused by a malfunctioning relay, or a control module driven solenoid or switch-These conditions can cause a sharp electrical surge. Normally, the condition will occur when the malfunctioning component is operating. - Improper installation of non-factory or aftermarket add on accessories such as lights, 2-way radios, amplifiers, electric motors, remote starters, alarm systems, cell phones, etc-These accessories may lead to interference while in use, but do not fail when the accessories are not in use. - Test for an open diode across the A/C compressor clutch and for other open diodes. Some relays may contain a clamping diode. - The generator may be allowing AC noise into the electrical system. INCORRECT CONTROL MODULE - There are only a few situations where reprogramming a control module is appropriate: A new service control module is installed. Page 2649 US English/Metric Conversion US English/Metric Conversion Page 8977 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link). - The wire insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. 5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold them between thumb and forefinger. 7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place. - Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction. - Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip. 8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool closes.Ensure that no strands of wire are cut. 10. Crimp the splice on each end (2). Page 3624 Disclaimer Knock Sensor Replacement (Left Side) Knock Sensor: Service and Repair Knock Sensor Replacement (Left Side) Knock Sensor Replacement (Left Side) Removal Procedure 1. Remove the mounting bolt for the knock sensor 1. 2. Disconnect the electrical connector of the knock sensor from the engine harness (3). 3. Remove the knock sensor (2) from the engine block (4). Installation Procedure 1. Reconnect the engine harness (3) and the knock sensor (2) electrical connectors. 2. Position the knock sensor 2 on the engine block (4). 3. Install the mounting bolt (1) for the knock sensor 2. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 4. Tighten the knock sensor mounting bolt (1). Tighten the knock sensor mounting bolt to 20 N.m (15 lb ft). Page 9010 Refer to the following table as a guide in selecting the correct test adapter for front probing connectors: Backprobe IMPORTANT: Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures. - Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector. - Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large of a test probe. - After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected, test for proper terminal contact. Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the connector. Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure SCAN TOOL SNAPSHOT PROCEDURE Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used Page 520 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. 4. Remove the dress cover by using a flat bladed tool to release the dress cover locking tabs and lift up on the dress cover. 5. Cut the tie wrap that holds the wires to the connector body. Diagram Information and Instructions Engine Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions Electrical Symbols Page 1693 Page 8217 Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair Mass Airflow Sensor/Intake Air Temperature Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure Important: Use care when handling the mass air flow (MAF)/intake air temperature (IAT) sensor. Do not dent, puncture, or otherwise damage the honeycell located at the air inlet end of the MAF/IAT. Do not touch the sensing elements or allow anything including cleaning solvents and lubricants to come in contact with them. Use a small amount of a non-silicone based lubricant, on the air duct only, to aid in installation. 1. Disconnect the MAF/IAT sensor electrical connector. 2. Loosen the clamps at the MAF/IAT sensor and the throttle body. 3. Remove the air cleaner outlet duct bolt. 4. Remove the air cleaner outlet duct. 5. Loosen the clamp attaching the MAF/IAT sensor to the air cleaner housing. 6. Remove the MAF/IAT sensor from the air cleaner housing. Installation Procedure Important: The embossed arrow on the MAF/IAT sensor indicates the proper air flow direction. The arrow must point toward the engine. Page 6214 - Yazaki has a wedge or arrow shape, similar to that shown. Delphi Connectors (Micro .64) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro 64 connectors. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. The lever lock may be located on the top or sides of the wire dress cover. Page 3401 View of typical connector. View of connector in released position. 1. Locate the assist lever at the back of the connector. Move the assist lever to the rear position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the dress cover. Page 2222 5. Insert the J 38125-557 (GM P/N 12122378) into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 6. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Connector Position Assurance Locks CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of the connector. CPAs are used in various connectors throughout the vehicle. CPAs are also used in all SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals, of the connector. Connector Repairs CONNECTOR REPAIRS Page 2160 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert a small flat-blade tool in the slot below the front loaded terminal position assurance (TPA) and pry up. 3. Remove the TPA by pulling it out of the connector. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-553 (GM P/N 15315247) on a slight upward angle into the cavity below the terminal to be removed. Ensure that the pointed on the end of the tool is facing the bottom of the terminal and it stays in contact with the terminal until it stops on the plastic terminal retainer. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 253 breakers are used. CIRCUIT BREAKER This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high current is removed. POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) CIRCUIT BREAKER This type greatly increases its resistance when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker will re-close within a second or 2. Circuit Protection - Fuses CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSES The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and examine the element in the fuse for an open (2). If not broken (1), also check for continuity using a DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one of equal current rating. Circuit Protection - Fusible Links CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSIBLE LINKS Page 5224 6. Gently pry the plastic terminal retainer down and carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (16-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, pull the two connector halves apart. Page 1836 Oxygen Sensor: Diagnostic Aids Arrows and Symbols Arrows and Symbols This Service Data uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations. Arrows and Symbols 1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow Basic Knowledge Required GENERAL ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures contained in the service manual. You should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current (amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram, as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. Decimal and Metric Equivalents Decimal and Metric Equivalents Page 8283 2. Locate the two indents of the terminal position assurance (TPA) located on the bottom of the connector body. Page 6872 Page 7479 It is very important to use the correct test adapter when testing for proper terminal contact of fuses and relays in a bussed electrical center (BEC). Use J-35616-35 to test for proper terminal contact. Failure to use J-35616-35 can result in improper diagnosis of the BEC. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Separate the connector halves. 2. Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body. 3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J-38125 , test that the retention force is significantly different between a good terminal and a suspect terminal. Replace the female terminal in question. FLAT WIRE (DOCK AND LOCK) CONNECTORS There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock) connectors on the harness side or the component side. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Remove the component in question. 2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side of the connector as oil from your skin may be a source of contamination as well. 3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other imperfections that could cause poor terminal contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are uniform and free of damage or deformation. 4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the on the flat wire harness connector in order to test the circuit in question. CONTROL MODULE/COMPONENT VOLTAGE AND GROUNDS Poor voltage or ground connections can cause widely varying symptoms. Test all control module voltage supply circuits. Many vehicles have multiple circuits supplying voltage to a control module. Other components in the system may have separate voltage supply circuits that may also need to be tested. Inspect connections at the module/component connectors, fuses, and any intermediate connections between the voltage source and the module/component. A test lamp or a DMM may indicate that voltage is present, but neither tests the ability of the circuit to carry sufficient current. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Power Distribution Schematics. - Test all control module ground and system ground circuits. The control module may have multiple ground circuits. Other components in the system may have separate grounds that may also need to be tested. Inspect grounds for clean and tight connections at the grounding point. Inspect the connections at the component and in splice packs, where applicable. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Ground Distribution Schematics. TEMPERATURE SENSITIVITY - An intermittent condition may occur when a component/connection reaches normal operating temperature. The condition may occur only when the component/connection is cold, or only when the component/connection is hot. - Freeze Frame, Failure Records, Snapshot, or Vehicle Data Recorder data may help with this type of intermittent condition, where applicable. - If the intermittent is related to heat, review the data for a relationship with the following: High ambient temperatures - Underhood/engine generated heat - Circuit generated heat due to a poor connection, or high electrical load - Higher than normal load conditions, towing, etc. - If the intermittent is related to cold, review the data for the following: Low ambient temperatures-In extremely low temperatures, ice may form in a connection or component. Inspect for water intrusion. - The condition only occurs on a cold start. - The condition goes away when the vehicle warms up. - Information from the customer may help to determine if the trouble follows a pattern that is temperature related. - If temperature is suspected of causing an intermittent fault condition, attempt to duplicate the condition. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required. ELECTROMAGNETIC INTERFERENCE (EMI) AND ELECTRICAL NOISE Some electrical components/circuits are sensitive to electromagnetic interference (EMI) or other types of electrical noise. Inspect for the following conditions: A misrouted harness that is too close to high voltage/high current devices such as secondary ignition components, motors, generator etc-These components may induce electrical noise on a circuit that could interfere with normal circuit operation. - Electrical system interference caused by a malfunctioning relay, or a control module driven solenoid or switch-These conditions can cause a sharp electrical surge. Normally, the condition will occur when the malfunctioning component is operating. - Improper installation of non-factory or aftermarket add on accessories such as lights, 2-way radios, amplifiers, electric motors, remote starters, alarm systems, cell phones, etc-These accessories may lead to interference while in use, but do not fail when the accessories are not in use. - Test for an open diode across the A/C compressor clutch and for other open diodes. Some relays may contain a clamping diode. - The generator may be allowing AC noise into the electrical system. INCORRECT CONTROL MODULE - There are only a few situations where reprogramming a control module is appropriate: A new service control module is installed. Page 2993 * The hose connections * The areas surrounding the connections Disconnect the CH-48027-2 (2) from the CH-48027-3 (4). 11. Disconnect the CH-48027-3 (4) from the fuel rail service port. 12. Remove the shop towel from around the fuel rail service port, and place in an approved gasoline container. 13. Install the fuel rail service port cap. 14. Install the engine cover, if required. 15. Tighten the fuel fill cap. Without CH-48027 Caution: Refer to Gasoline/Gasoline Vapors Caution. Caution: Remove the fuel tank cap and relieve the fuel system pressure before servicing the fuel system in order to reduce the risk of personal injury. After you relieve the fuel system pressure, a small amount of fuel may be released when servicing the fuel lines, the fuel injection pump, or the connections. In order to reduce the risk of personal injury, cover the fuel system components with a shop towel before disconnection. This will catch any fuel that may leak out. Place the towel in an approved container when the disconnection is complete. 1. Loosen the fuel fill cap in order to relieve the fuel tank vapor pressure. 2. Remove the engine cover, if required. 3. Remove the fuel rail service port cap. 4. Wrap a shop towel around the fuel rail service port and using a small flat bladed tool, depress (open) the fuel rail test port valve. 5. Remove the shop towel from around the fuel rail service port, and place in an approved gasoline container. 6. Install the fuel rail service port cap. 7. Install the engine cover, if required. 8. Tighten the fuel fill cap. Page 2493 2. Use a small flat-bladed tool to release the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting the tool in the small recess on the side of the connector and pushing up until the TPA releases from the connector body. The TPA should raise just slightly. Do not try to remove the TPA. IMPORTANT: The TPA on this connector cannot be removed unless the terminals are removed first. The TPA will come out of the connector body, but only slightly. When the TPA is slightly raised the terminals can be removed. Using excessive force to remove the TPA with the terminals still in the connector will damage the connector. 3. Repeat the process for the other side of the connector. 4. Ensure that the TPA is in the proper position to remove the terminals. Page 4702 20. Extract a portion of the ECT sensor harness wiring and connector from the protective conduit. Cut off the ECT sensor harness connector and wiring. 21. Determine a routing path for the ECT sensor jumper harness wires so that they can be secured TO or WITHIN an existing protective conduit. Note This step is to set up and verify the length of wiring that is required before cutting. 22. Route the ECT sensor jumper wires and then enclose them in their own protective conduit in order to VERIFY the length that is required. 23. Cut the ECT sensor jumper wires to the appropriate length. Note Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splice or connector. 24. Splice the ECT sensor jumper wires to the ORIGINAL ECT HARNESS LOCATION using DuraSeal weatherproof splices. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves in SI. Note Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splice or connector. 25. Splice the ECT sensor jumper wires to the ECT SENSOR HARNESS CONNECTOR using DuraSeal weatherproof splices. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves in SI. 26. Connect the ECT sensor harness connector to the ECT sensor. 27. Secure the ECT sensor jumper wires that are in their own protective conduit TO or WITHIN the existing harness conduit using tie straps. Important You MUST run the engine at the specified RPM and until it reaches normal operating temperature and then allow it to idle as indicated in SI. The engine MUST then be allowed to cool down in order to top off the coolant level as needed. 28. Fill the cooling system to the proper level. Refer to Cooling System Draining and Filling in SI. 29. Pressure test the cooling system. Refer to Cooling System Leak Testing in SI. 30. Use a scan tool to clear any DTCs. Relocating the Engine Coolant Heater Cord Important For reference, the procedure and graphics that are shown are from a Chevrolet Silverado, but are similar for the other vehicles listed above. 1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Ask the customer where they would prefer the extension cord to exit from the engine compartment in order to determine the required extension cord length. 3. Obtain an extension cord with the following features: - 120 volt - 14/3 gauge - 15A capacity - Three prong - Polarized plug and receptacle - Chemical resistant - Grounded terminals - Designed for use in a cold outdoor environment - Outer jacket resistant to deterioration from moisture, abrasion and exposure to sunlight - Maximum length of 2.5-3 m (8-10 ft) 4. Release enough of the clips that retain the engine coolant heater cord to the vehicle to provide the necessary length for repositioning. 5. Apply dielectric grease to the electrical contacts of the heater cord receptacle and the extension cord plug to prevent corrosion. Use GM P/N 12345579 (in Canada, use P/N 10953481) or an equivalent. 6. Connect the heater cord receptacle to the extension cord plug and wipe OFF any excess grease. Page 2779 Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Adjustments Park/Neutral Position Switch Adjustment Important: ^ The following procedure is for vehicles that have not had the switch removed or replaced. If the switch has been removed or replaced, refer to Park/Neutral Position Switch Replacement for the proper adjustment procedure. ^ Apply the parking brake. ^ The engine must start in the P (Park) or N (Neutral) positions only. ^ Check the switch for proper operation. If adjustment is required, proceed as follows: 1. Place the transmission range selector in the N (Neutral) position. 2. With an assistant in the drivers seat, raise the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 3. Loosen the park/neutral position switch mounting bolts. 4. With the vehicle in the N (Neutral) position, rotate the switch while the assistant attempts to start the engine. 5. Following a successful start, turn the engine OFF. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 6. Tighten the bolts securing the switch to the transmission. Tighten the bolts to 25 N.m (18 lb ft). 7. Lower the vehicle. 8. Check the switch for proper operation. The engine must start in the P (Park) or N (Neutral) positions only. 9. Replace the park/neutral position switch if proper operation can not be achieved. Refer to Park/Neutral Position Switch Replacement. Page 219 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the TPA. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the nose piece. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. Page 7205 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry one side of the nose piece up to the pre-stage position. When the nose piece is in the pre-staged position, the nose piece will be raised above the connector body the length of the step in the nose piece. 7. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry the other side of the piece to the pre-stage position. If the nose piece is higher than the first step in the nose piece, gently push down on the nose piece until it meets with resistance from the connector body, you should feel the nose piece click into position. Page 1692 Page 2564 If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200 DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J 39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected. IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J 39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and maximum (MAX) values measured. 1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of a suspected circuit to the other. 2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J 39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep). IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value in order to record the full change. 5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling the connections or the wiring, test driving, or performing other operations. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions. 6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9. Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist. Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections TESTING FOR INTERMITTENT CONDITIONS AND POOR CONNECTIONS TOOLS REQUIRED - J 35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit - J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit When the condition is not currently present, but is indicated in DTC history, the cause may be intermittent. An intermittent may also be the cause when there is a customer complaint, but the symptom cannot be duplicated. Refer to the Symptom Table of the system that is suspect of causing the condition before trying to locate an intermittent condition. Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the following items: Wiring broken inside the insulation - Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector - Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself, and corrosion in the wire to terminal contact area, etc. - Pierced or damaged insulation can allow moisture to enter the wiring causing corrosion. The conductor can corrode inside the insulation, with little visible evidence. Look for swollen and stiff sections of wire in the suspect circuits. - Wiring which has been pinched, cut, or its insulation rubbed through may cause an intermittent open or short as the bare area touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle. - Wiring that comes in contact with hot or exhaust components - Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required, in order to verify the customer concern. - Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. - Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis and Vehicle Data Recorder operation. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any inline connectors before replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation. Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination, usually in the underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit. Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper adapter. Always use the J 35616 when probing connectors. Other causes of terminal deformation are improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT IN BUSSED ELECTRICAL CENTERS (BEC) Page 3287 MOLEX CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. 2. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. Page 3744 View of a typical Micro 64 connector. Depress the lock and pull the lever over and past the lock. Page 2354 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the TPA. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the nose piece. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. Page 1065 Power Seat Switch: Service and Repair Driver Seat Adjuster Memory Switch Replacement DRIVER SEAT ADJUSTER MEMORY SWITCH REPLACEMENT REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Lift up on the front edge of the door lock and side window switch (1) in order to release the front retaining clip. 2. Lift up on the rear edge of the switch panel in order to release the 2 rear retaining clips. 3. Remove the electrical connector (2) from the memory seat switch. 4. Remove the memory seat switch from the lock and door lock and side window switch (1). INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 1. Position the memory seat switch to the lock and door lock and side window switch (1). 2. Connect the electrical connector (2) to the memory seat switch. 3. Install the door lock and side window switch (1). Verify that the front retaining clips and the rear retaining clips are fully seated. Page 509 Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. FCI Connectors FCI CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 9049 Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. FCI Connectors FCI CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 5551 - Yazaki has a wedge or arrow shape, similar to that shown. Delphi Connectors (Micro .64) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro 64 connectors. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. The lever lock may be located on the top or sides of the wire dress cover. Page 1745 4. Use a small flat-blade tool to slide the terminal position assurance (TPA) up one notch on both ends of the connector. The TPA is located underneath the wire dress cover. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 7156 If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200 DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J 39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected. IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J 39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and maximum (MAX) values measured. 1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of a suspected circuit to the other. 2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J 39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep). IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value in order to record the full change. 5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling the connections or the wiring, test driving, or performing other operations. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions. 6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9. Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist. Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections TESTING FOR INTERMITTENT CONDITIONS AND POOR CONNECTIONS TOOLS REQUIRED - J 35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit - J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit When the condition is not currently present, but is indicated in DTC history, the cause may be intermittent. An intermittent may also be the cause when there is a customer complaint, but the symptom cannot be duplicated. Refer to the Symptom Table of the system that is suspect of causing the condition before trying to locate an intermittent condition. Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the following items: Wiring broken inside the insulation - Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector - Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself, and corrosion in the wire to terminal contact area, etc. - Pierced or damaged insulation can allow moisture to enter the wiring causing corrosion. The conductor can corrode inside the insulation, with little visible evidence. Look for swollen and stiff sections of wire in the suspect circuits. - Wiring which has been pinched, cut, or its insulation rubbed through may cause an intermittent open or short as the bare area touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle. - Wiring that comes in contact with hot or exhaust components - Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required, in order to verify the customer concern. - Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. - Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis and Vehicle Data Recorder operation. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any inline connectors before replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation. Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination, usually in the underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit. Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper adapter. Always use the J 35616 when probing connectors. Other causes of terminal deformation are improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT IN BUSSED ELECTRICAL CENTERS (BEC) Page 2478 MOLEX CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. 2. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. Page 4235 2. Tap the key (122) into the keyway until both ends of the key bottom onto the crankshaft. 3. Install the crankshaft sprocket (207) onto the front of the crankshaft. Align the crankshaft key with the crankshaft sprocket keyway. Page 2144 8. Insert the J 38125-213 into the small terminal release hole on the nose piece and gently pull on the back of the wire. 9. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Repairing Connector Terminals REPAIRING CONNECTOR TERMINALS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following: Push to Seat terminals - Pull to Seat terminals Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your terminal repair. The J-38125 contains further information. 1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.For cable seal terminals, remove the seal. 2. Apply the correct cable seal per gage size of the wire, if used.Slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation removal. 3. Remove the insulation. 4. For sealed terminals only, align the seal with the end of the cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal.For sealed terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal. 6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.For sealed terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable. 8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals excepting Micro-Pack 100.64 size. Soldering Micro-Pack 100 World terminals may damage the terminal. Sumitomo Connectors SUMITOMO CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 464 Page 4949 3. Use a small flat-bladed tool to gently pry off the dress cover by inserting the tool under the cover opposite the harness side and prying up. 4. Remove the cover. 5. Using a small flat-bladed tool, push on the side of the nose piece retainer while pushing the nose piece forward with your thumb. This will release the terminal position assurance (TPA). 6. Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) into the corresponding terminal release cavity. The release cavities are the 2 center rows of cavities on one half of the connector. Page 8219 7. Connect the MAF/IAT electrical connector. Page 7742 Page 4239 11. Install the J 42386-A and bolts. Use 1 M10-1.5 x 120 mm bolt and 1 M10-1.5 x 45 mm bolt for proper tool operation. Tighten the J 42386-A bolts to 50 N.m (37 lb ft). 12. Tighten the camshaft sprocket bolt. 1. Tighten the camshaft sprocket bolt a first pass to 75 N.m (55 lb ft). 2. Tighten the camshaft sprocket bolt a final pass an additional 50 degrees using the J 45059. 13. Remove the J 42386-A and bolts. 14. Remove the automatic transmission flex plate or manual transmission flywheel and bolts. Refer to Engine Flywheel Removal. 15. Install the oil pump. Refer to Oil Pump, Screen, and Crankshaft Oil Deflector Replacement. Page 8809 The first connector design of the Micro-Pack 100W (1) has a white connector interface that holds the terminals. The second design of the Micro-Pack 100W (2) has a gray interface to hold the terminals. Also, the first design has terminal cavities that are further apart (3 mm centerline) and offset from the other row of terminal cavities in the connector. The second design has terminals cavities that are closer together (2.54 mm centerline) and aligned vertically. One other way to identify the second design is the thin strip of material that runs along the outside of the cavities. IMPORTANT: There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W terminals which are very similar. Ensure that you have the correct terminal before crimping the new terminal to the wire. The first design connector uses the longer terminal (1) that has a raised area in front of the recess in the terminal. The second design connector uses the shorter terminal without the raised area. Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro-Pack 100W connectors. Some Micro-Pack 100W connector disassembly procedures will vary. Use this procedure as a guide. 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 4022 3. Install the engine mount to the engine. Tighten the engine mount bolts to 50 N.m (37 lb ft). 4. Install the engine mount frame bracket to the frame. 5. Install the retaining bolts to the engine mount frame bracket. 6. Install the left side engine mount frame bracket. 7. Install the retaining bolts to the left side engine mount frame bracket. Tighten the bolts to 100 N.m (74 lb ft). 8. Lower the engine, aligning the engine mount studs with the holes in the frame bracket. 9. Remove the pole jack and block of wood. 10. Tighten the engine mount nuts. Tighten the nuts to 50 N.m (37 lb ft). Page 7548 breakers are used. CIRCUIT BREAKER This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high current is removed. POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) CIRCUIT BREAKER This type greatly increases its resistance when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker will re-close within a second or 2. Circuit Protection - Fuses CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSES The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and examine the element in the fuse for an open (2). If not broken (1), also check for continuity using a DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one of equal current rating. Circuit Protection - Fusible Links CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSIBLE LINKS Page 7661 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 640 2. Connect the MDI to the Data Link Connector (DLC) of the vehicle. Note Use the USB port to make the following MDI connection: 3. Connect the MDI to a PC or laptop that has been downloaded with the GDS application from TIS2WEB. Note At least one Diagnostic Package must be installed on the PC to perform diagnostics. If GDS was just installed, select: Add New Diagnostic Package and then select: a Diagnostic Package to download. 4. Click: On the GDS icon on the PC. 5. The Login Page will appear. 6. Select: A User. 7. The ID Screen will appear. 8. Select: The serial number of the MDI being used. 9. Select: Connect. 10. Verify that the system status is ready by observing for a flashing PC light icon on the MDI. 11. Select: Make, Model and Model Year, in order to build the vehicle. 12. Click: Upload VIN, to allow the VIN to be reported to the PC. 13. At: The Verification step, turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. 14. Select: Next Action. 15. The Home Page will appear. 16. Select: Next. 17. The Diagnostic Screen will appear. Note Due to vehicle build, software and RPO variations, GDS may ask for additional information in Step 18. 18. Select: Engine ID, if prompted. 19. Select: Module Diagnostics. 20. Select: ECM. 21. Select: ID Information. 22. The Diagnostics page will appear. Typical View of GDS Calibration History Screen Note GDS is capable of displaying up to 10 Calibration History events. 23. Select: Calibration History from the drop down menu in order to display the following items on the screen: - Calibration History Buffer - Number of Calibration History Events Stored - Calibration Part Number History - Calibration Verification Number History 24. Select: Screenshot. 25. Name and save the file in an appropriate folder. 26. Select : Print, and retain a copy of the screenshot with the repair order. Page 8295 5. Once the nose piece retainers are relaxed, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should raise slightly. 6. On the opposite side of the nose piece, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should release completely. If the nose piece does not come off, repeat the procedure on the opposite side. Page 6355 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry one side of the nose piece up to the pre-stage position. When the nose piece is in the pre-staged position, the nose piece will be raised above the connector body the length of the step in the nose piece. 7. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry the other side of the piece to the pre-stage position. If the nose piece is higher than the first step in the nose piece, gently push down on the nose piece until it meets with resistance from the connector body, you should feel the nose piece click into position. Page 7472 Checking Aftermarket Accessories CHECKING AFTERMARKET ACCESSORIES Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits: - CAUTION: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol. - NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice. OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol. Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the cause of the problems. Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include: Power feeds connected to points other than the battery - Antenna location - Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring - Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line - Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories. Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions INDUCING INTERMITTENT FAULT CONDITIONS TOOLS REQUIRED J 25070 Heat Gun Many intermittent open or shorted circuits are affected by harness/connector movement that is caused by vibration, engine torque, bumps/rough pavement, etc. In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness if the malfunction appears to be Page 1653 6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias. Reference the appropriate service manual wiring schematic to obtain the correct diode installation position. 7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for the soldering equipment. 8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed. 9. IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode attachment points with tape. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape. Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable SPLICING TWISTED OR SHIELDED CABLE Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable. 1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splice is made. 3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire. Staggering the splices by 65 mm (2.5 in) is recommended. 4. IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical contact with the drain wire. Re-assemble the cable. Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape. - Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1). - Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire. - Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape. Page 704 - In some cases Delphi will actually be printed on the connector. If Delphi is not printed on the connector, look for PED. In both cases there is no specific orientation for Delphi or PED and they can appear anywhere on the connector. - FCI connectors may have the FCI logo on their connectors. The logo is the letters FCI with an "A" above it. - JAE connector have JAE in small letters on their connectors. Page 3274 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) and slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. Page 4652 3. Ensure that the terminal release tang access panel is in the correct location to access the terminals. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) into the terminal release tang access slot located behind the access panel of the connector and press down on the terminal while carefully pulling the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Tyco/AMP Connectors (0.25 Cap) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (025 CAP) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component by pressing down on the connector position assurance (CPA). Page 2753 Tire Pressure Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Tires - Minimizing Damage to TPM Sensors INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 08-03-10-007 Date: May 16, 2008 Subject: Minimizing Damage to Tire Pressure Monitor (TPM) Sensors During Tire Mounting/Dismounting Models: 2009 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2009 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X with Wheel Mounted Tire Pressure Sensors Minimizing Damage To TPM Sensors All GM vehicles now in production and sold in the U.S., as well as many vehicles sold in Canada, feature Tire Pressure Monitoring Systems that have valve stem mounted Tire Pressure Sensors. When dismounting and mounting tires, care must be taken when breaking the bead loose from the wheel. If the tire machines bead breaking fixture is positioned too close to the tire pressure sensor, as the tire bead breaks away from the wheel it may be forced into, or catch on the edge of the tire pressure sensor. This can damage the sensor and require the sensor to be replaced. Care must also be taken when transferring the tire bead to the other side of the wheel rim. As the tire machine rotates and the tire bead is stretched around the wheel rim, the bead can come in contact with the sensor if it is not correctly positioned in relation to the mounting/dismounting head prior to tire mounting/dismounting. This can also cause sensor damage requiring replacement. Procedure Notice: Use a tire changing machine in order to dismount tires. Do not use hand tools or tire irons alone in order to remove the tire from the wheel. Damage to the tire beads or the wheel rim could result. Notice: Do not scratch or damage the clear coating on aluminum wheels with the tire changing equipment. Scratching the clear coating could cause the aluminum wheel to corrode and the clear coating to peel from the wheel. 1. Remove the valve core from the valve stem. 2. Deflate the tire completely. Important: Rim-clamp European-type tire changers are recommended. 3. Use the tire changer in order to remove the tire from the wheel. Follow steps 4-7 to remove the tire from the wheel. 4. When separating the tire bead from the wheel position the bead breaking fixture 90, 180 and 270 degrees from the valve stem. Page 3960 7. Rotate the crankshaft until the number one piston is at top dead center (TDC) of the compression stroke. In this position, cylinder number one rocker arms will be off lobe lift, and the crankshaft sprocket key will be at the 1:30 position. The engine firing order is 1, 8, 7, 2, 6, 5, 4, 3. Cylinders 1, 3, 5 and 7 are the left bank. Cylinder 2, 4, 6 and 8 are the right bank. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 8. With the engine in the number one firing position, tighten the following valve rocker arm bolts: ^ Tighten cylinders 1, 2, 7 and 8 exhaust valve rocker arm bolts to 30 N.m (22 lb ft). ^ Tighten cylinders 1, 3, 4 and 5 intake valve rocker arm bolts to 30 N.m (22 lb ft). 9. Rotate the crankshaft 360 degrees. 10. Tighten the following valve rocker arm bolts: ^ Tighten cylinders 3, 4, 5 and 6 exhaust valve rocker arm bolts to 30 N.m (22 lb ft). ^ Tighten cylinders 2, 6, 7 and 8 intake valve rocker arm bolts to 30 N.m (22 lb ft). 11. Install the valve rocker arm cover. Refer to Valve Rocker Arm Cover Replacement - Left Side or to Valve Rocker Arm Cover Replacement - Right Side. Page 8772 All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system. Page 7859 1. Connect the HO2S electrical connector (2). 2. Install the CPA retainer. Important: A special anti-seize compound is used on the HO2S threads. The compound consists of liquid graphite and glass beads. The graphite tends to burn away, but the glass beads remain, making the sensor easier to remove. New, or service replacement sensors already have the compound applied to the threads. If the sensor is removed from an exhaust component and if for any reason the sensor is to be reinstalled, the threads must have anti-seize compound applied before the reinstallation. 3. If reinstalling the old sensor, coat the threads with anti-seize compound GM P/N 12377953, or equivalent. Notice: Refer to Component Fastener Tightening Notice. Important: If the HO2S sensor is connected to the main wiring harness during installation. Rotate the HO2S sensor several turns counterclockwise before threading the HO2S sensor into the catalytic converter. This action of initially reverse winding of the pigtail wires will prevent a condition where the HO2S sensor pigtail wires become severely twisted or binding once the HO2S sensor is installed into the catalytic converter. 4. Install the HO2S (2). Tighten the sensor to 42 N.m (31 lb ft). 5. Lower the vehicle. Page 4841 2. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 5589 4. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the rear of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. 5. Once the locking tabs are unlocked, slide the inner connector out of the rear of the connector housing. Page 8451 breakers are used. CIRCUIT BREAKER This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high current is removed. POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) CIRCUIT BREAKER This type greatly increases its resistance when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker will re-close within a second or 2. Circuit Protection - Fuses CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSES The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and examine the element in the fuse for an open (2). If not broken (1), also check for continuity using a DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one of equal current rating. Circuit Protection - Fusible Links CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSIBLE LINKS Page 4383 5. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove TPA from the connector. 6. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Engine Mount Replacement - Left Engine Mount: Service and Repair Engine Mount Replacement - Left Engine Mount Replacement - Left Side (Two-Wheel Drive) Removal Procedure 1. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 2. Remove the front tire and wheels. Refer to Tire and Wheel Removal and Installation. 3. Remove the engine protection shield. Refer to Engine Protection Shield Replacement. 4. Remove the shock module. Refer to Shock Module Replacement. 5. Remove the lower engine mount retaining nuts from the engine mount frame bracket. 6. Remove the 3 mounting bolts that secure the upper engine mount bracket to the engine block bracket. Page 7997 Release the tabs that are holding the wiredress cover to the connector body. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the slots on both ends of the connector body. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. J 38125-216 can also be used to remove the nose piece. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by lifting the terminal retaining tabs on the inside of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 374 IMPORTANT: Ensure that the dress cover and connector body are both in the released position before reassembling. Failure to do so may cause damage to the connector and component. Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (0.64) BOSCH CONNECTORS (0.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While pressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock until the lever is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Pull the rubber boot that covers the wires back to expose the end of the connector dress cover. 4. Place the connector locking lever in the center of the connector. 5. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs that are on the wire end of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover and connector body and pry up. Page 5545 5. Insert the J 38125-557 (GM P/N 12122378) into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 6. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Connector Position Assurance Locks CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of the connector. CPAs are used in various connectors throughout the vehicle. CPAs are also used in all SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals, of the connector. Connector Repairs CONNECTOR REPAIRS Page 3980 1. Clean the cylinder head valve spring seat and/or shim area. 2. Lubricate the valve guide and valve stem oil seal with clean engine oil. 3. Install the valve stem oil seal/shim assembly (1, 5). 4. Install the valve spring (4). 5. Install the valve spring cap (3). 6. Compress the valve spring using the J 38606. 7. Install the valve keys. 1. Use grease in order to hold the valve keys in place. 2. Make sure the keys seat properly in the groove of the valve stem. 3. Carefully release the valve spring pressure, making sure the valve keys stay in place. 4. Remove J 38606. 5. Tap the end of the valve stem with a plastic faced hammer to seat the keys (if necessary). 8. Remove J 22794 from the spark plug port. Page 5543 6. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs located on the opposite side of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover at the connector end and pry up. 7. Remove the dress cover. 8. Cut the tie wrap on the wire bundle. 9. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting a small flat-bladed tool into the small slot in the end of the slider and pushing on the TPA until it comes out of the connector. When the TPA exits the opposite side of the connector, gasp the TPA and pull it completely out of the connector. 10. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 6023 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the DuraSeal splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of a connector. CPAs are used in all SIR System connectors and also in some connectors of other systems. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals of a connection. TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE CLIPS IMPORTANT: When making a splice in an area that may be exposed to moisture use a crimp and seal splice sleeve instead of a Splice Clip. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. Page 6303 IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals. Front probe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the connector. IMPORTANT: When probing female 0.64 terminals, it is important to use the correct adapter. There have been some revisions to the test adapter for 0.64 terminals. The proper adapter for 0.64 terminals is the J 35616-64B which has a gold terminal and a black wire between the base and tip. Failure to use the proper test adapter may result in damage to the terminal being tested and improper diagnosis. NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Page 7545 6. Gently pry the plastic terminal retainer down and carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (16-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, pull the two connector halves apart. Page 3320 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link). - The wire insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. 5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold them between thumb and forefinger. 7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place. - Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction. - Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip. 8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool closes.Ensure that no strands of wire are cut. 10. Crimp the splice on each end (2). Page 1595 4. Once the front 2 locks are unlocked, lift the front of the dress cover and pull it forward. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the small slot on the TPA and pushing down until the TPA releases. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to angle or rock the J 38125-21 tool when inserting it into the connector or the tool may break. Insert the J 38125-21 (GM P/N 15381651-2) tool into the round canal between the terminals cavities at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to repair Micro 64 connector terminals. The Micro 64 connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-64 (M jaw) was developed to crimp Micro 64 terminals. The J 38125-64 crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. The J 38125-64 crimping tool is also designed to crimp both the wire and the insulation at the same time. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro 64 terminals. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. 1. Cut the wire as close to the damaged terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. Page 4754 6. Heater outlet hose to engine (6). 7. Heater inlet hose to front of dash (7). 8. Heater outlet hose to front of dash (8). Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models) Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models) Page 1640 breakers are used. CIRCUIT BREAKER This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high current is removed. POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) CIRCUIT BREAKER This type greatly increases its resistance when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker will re-close within a second or 2. Circuit Protection - Fuses CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSES The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and examine the element in the fuse for an open (2). If not broken (1), also check for continuity using a DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one of equal current rating. Circuit Protection - Fusible Links CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSIBLE LINKS Page 6004 6. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by pressing on the tang. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (SENSOR) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) tool into the cavity on the lower right hand face of the connector until the terminal release tang access panel slides over. Page 6528 Refer to the following table as a guide in selecting the correct test adapter for front probing connectors: Backprobe IMPORTANT: Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures. - Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector. - Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large of a test probe. - After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected, test for proper terminal contact. Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the connector. Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure SCAN TOOL SNAPSHOT PROCEDURE Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used Wheels - Chrome Wheel Staining/Pitting/Corrosion Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels - Chrome Wheel Staining/Pitting/Corrosion INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 00-03-10-002F Date: April 21, 2011 Subject: Chemical Staining, Pitting, Corrosion and/or Spotted Appearance of Chromed Aluminum Wheels Models: 2012 and Prior GM Cars and Trucks Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update model years, suggest additional restorative products and add additional corrosion information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 00-03-10-002E (Section 03 - Suspension). Important You may give a copy of this bulletin to the customer. What is Chemical Staining of Chrome Wheels? Figure 1 Chemical staining in most cases results from acid based cleaners (refer to Figure 1 for an example). These stains are frequently milky, black, or greenish in appearance. They result from using cleaning solutions that contain acids on chrome wheels. Soap and water is usually sufficient to clean wheels. If the customer insists on using a wheel cleaner they should only use one that specifically states that it is safe for chromed wheels and does not contain anything in the following list. (Dealers should also survey any products they use during prep or normal cleaning of stock units for these chemicals.) - Ammonium Bifluoride (fluoride source for dissolution of chrome) - Hydrofluoric Acid (directly dissolves chrome) - Hydrochloric Acid (directly dissolves chrome) - Sodium Dodecylbenzenesulfonic Acid - Sulfamic Acid - Phosphoric Acid - Hydroxyacetic Acid Notice Many wheel cleaner instructions advise to take care to avoid contact with painted surfaces. Most customers think of painted surfaces as the fenders, quarter panels and other exterior sheet metal. Many vehicles have painted brake calipers. Acidic wheel cleaners may craze, crack, or discolor the paint on the brake calipers. Damage from wheel cleaners is not covered under the vehicle new car warranty. Soap and water applied with a soft brush is usually all that is required to clean the calipers. Whenever any wheel cleaner is used, it must be THOROUGHLY rinsed off of the wheel with clean, clear water. Special care must be taken to rinse under the hub cap, balance weights, wheel nuts, lug nut caps, between the wheel cladding and off the back side of the wheel. Wheels returned to the Warranty Parts Center (WPC) that exhibit damage from wheel cleaners most often have the damage around and under the wheel weight where the cleaner was incompletely flushed away. Notice Page 4979 Page 5503 Page 8115 Page 4895 - A control module from another vehicle is installed. - Revised software/calibration files have been released for this vehicle. - IMPORTANT: DO NOT re-program the control module with the SAME software/calibration files that are already present in the control module. This is not an effective repair for any type of concern. Verify that the control module contains the correct software/calibration. If incorrect programming is found, reprogram the control module with the most current software/calibration. Refer to Control Module References for replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Testing for Short to Ground TESTING FOR SHORT TO GROUND NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 4. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit. With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is a short to ground in the circuit. Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2. Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). - When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. - If the DMM does not display voltage 4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is shorted. Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A DIGITAL MULTIMETER NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the powertrain control module (PCM), should only be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200 Digital Multimeter (DMM). The J 39200 instruction manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminage even though voltage is present. The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity. IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading. Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the measurement. Page 7088 Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size. REPAIRING A FUSIBLE LINK IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient overload protection. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. Flat Wire Repairs FLAT WIRE REPAIRS NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced. GMLAN Wiring Repairs GMLAN WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The GM Local Area Network (GMLAN) System requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working on GMLAN connectors and terminals. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items in order to repair the GMLAN wiring: Dura Seal splice sleeves - A wire stripping tool - J 38125-8 Crimping Tool (GM P/N 12085115) - J 38125-5 Ultra Torch Special Tool (GM P/N 12085116) The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. - A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors GMLAN REPAIRS IMPORTANT: When making a repair to any GMLAN network, the original wire length after the repair must be the same length as before the repair. If the network is a twisted pair, the twist must be maintained after the repair is completed. GMLAN has 2 types of networks, low speed and high speed. Low speed GMLAN has a single wire and works at slow speeds. High speed GMLAN has 2 wires in a twisted pair and works at higher speeds. For more information on GMLAN, refer to Data Link Communications Description and Operation. GMLAN CONNECTOR TERMINAL REPAIR IMPORTANT: A service terminal can be used to replace damaged connector terminals for both high speed and low speed GMLAN systems. When making a connector terminal repair on a GMLAN high speed system with twisted pair wires, do not untwist the wires more than necessary to make the repair. The terminals in the GMLAN system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are available in the J-38125. If the individual terminals are damaged on any GMLAN connection, use the appropriate connector repair procedure in order to repair the terminal. GMLAN WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 6070 If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200 DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J 39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected. IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J 39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and maximum (MAX) values measured. 1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of a suspected circuit to the other. 2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J 39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep). IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value in order to record the full change. 5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling the connections or the wiring, test driving, or performing other operations. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions. 6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9. Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist. Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections TESTING FOR INTERMITTENT CONDITIONS AND POOR CONNECTIONS TOOLS REQUIRED - J 35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit - J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit When the condition is not currently present, but is indicated in DTC history, the cause may be intermittent. An intermittent may also be the cause when there is a customer complaint, but the symptom cannot be duplicated. Refer to the Symptom Table of the system that is suspect of causing the condition before trying to locate an intermittent condition. Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the following items: Wiring broken inside the insulation - Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector - Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself, and corrosion in the wire to terminal contact area, etc. - Pierced or damaged insulation can allow moisture to enter the wiring causing corrosion. The conductor can corrode inside the insulation, with little visible evidence. Look for swollen and stiff sections of wire in the suspect circuits. - Wiring which has been pinched, cut, or its insulation rubbed through may cause an intermittent open or short as the bare area touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle. - Wiring that comes in contact with hot or exhaust components - Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required, in order to verify the customer concern. - Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. - Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis and Vehicle Data Recorder operation. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any inline connectors before replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation. Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination, usually in the underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit. Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper adapter. Always use the J 35616 when probing connectors. Other causes of terminal deformation are improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT IN BUSSED ELECTRICAL CENTERS (BEC) Page 2337 - JST connectors have JST in small letters on their connectors, similar to that above. The location of the logo will vary with the connector size and style. - Kostel has an "LK" with a circle around it. These connector are usually used as a transmissions connection and are currently use on some Cadillac vehicles. Page 2754 5. Position the wheel and tire so the valve stem is situated at the 2 o'clock position relative to the head. The tire iron or pry bar can be inserted when prying the outer tire bead up and over the mounting/dismounting head. 6. Position the wheel and tire so that the valve stem is situated again at the 2 o'clock position relative to the head. The tire iron or pry bar can be inserted when prying the inner tire bead up and over the mounting/dismounting head. 7. Remove all residual liquid sealant from the inside of the tire and wheel surfaces. If any tire sealant is noted upon tire dismounting on vehicles equipped with TPM replace the tire pressure sensor. 8. Use a wire brush or coarse steel wool in order to remove any rubber, light rust or corrosion from the wheel bead seats. Important: If bead seat corrosion has been identified as an air loss concern on the wheel being worked on, refer to GM Service Bulletin # 08-03-10-006 for additional information on correcting the leak. 9. Apply GM P/N 12345884 (in Canada, P/N 5728223) or equivalent to the tire bead and the wheel rim. Page 8045 9. The illustration shows a cutaway view of the connector to aid the technician in releasing the terminal retainer. 10. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Terminal Position Assurance Locks TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Tyco/Amp Connectors (CM 42-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (CM 42-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the connector body and pull the CPA out. The CPA is on the wire harness side of connector. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Diagrams Data Link Connector (DLC) Page 5238 11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the solder equipment. 12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. 13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to cover the first piece of tape. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE SLEEVES TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit IMPORTANT: Use only dura seal splice sleeves. Other splice sleeves may not protect the splice from moisture or provide a good electrical connection. Use duraseal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. Use duraseal splice sleeves where there is special requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire using duraseal splice sleeves. Page 8245 Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested: - Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. - Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a component or to other harnesses. - If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A TEST LAMP TOOLS REQUIRED J 35616-200 Test Light - Probe Kit NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminate even though voltage is present. The J 35616-200 is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair of leads. To properly operate this tool use the following procedures. When testing for voltage: 1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested. When testing for ground: 1. Attach one lead to battery positive voltage. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where ground should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is ground at the point being tested. Using Connector Test Adapters USING CONNECTOR TEST ADAPTERS NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Using Fused Jumper Wires USING FUSED JUMPER WIRES TOOLS REQUIRED J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged. The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested. AFL/ECP Connectors AFL/EPC CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 3550 Tire Pressure Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Tire Monitor System - TPM Sensor Information INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 08-03-16-003 Date: May 12, 2008 Subject: Warranty Reduction - Transfer of Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensors to Replacement Wheels and Allowable TPM Sensor Replacements Models: 2000-2009 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2003-2009 HUMMER H2 2006-2009 HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7x with On-Wheel TPM Sensors TPM Sensor / Wheel Warranty Reviews During the last warranty review period it was noted that wheels being returned under the GM New Vehicle Warranty were being shipped back to General Motors with the TPM sensor still attached to the wheel. Return rates ran as high as 60% with the TPM sensors still attached. Operational TPM sensors should not be returned to GM and are to be transferred to replacement wheels if they become necessary. Important: Operational TPM Sensors that are returned under warranty to General Motors will be charged back to the dealer.Sensors have a 10 year /150,000 mile (240,000 km) battery life, and should be transferred if one or more wheels are replaced. TPM Valve Stem / Grommet (0-ring) Replacement When the TPM sensors are transferred to new wheels you should replace the component used to seal the TPM sensor stem to the wheel. On sensors with an aluminum stem and visible nut on the outside of the wheel a replacement grommet (0-ring) should be used to assure a proper seal. The sensor retaining nut (except Aveo) should be tightened to 7 N.m (62 lb in) for all vehicles except Pontiac Vibe (4.0 N.m (35.4 lb in)). Important: ^ DO NOT overtorque the retaining nut. Notice: ^ Factory installed TPM Sensors come with plastic aluminum or nickel-plated brass stem caps. These caps should not be changed. Chrome plated steel caps may cause corrosion of aluminum valve stems due to incompatibility of the metals. On current style sensors the entire rubber stem is replaceable. The service interval on the revised TPM sensor with replaceable stem is the same as for any other traditional valve stem. Replace the stem at the time of tire replacement sensor transfer or whenever air seepage is suspected at the valve stem. When replacing the valve stem tighten the screw to 1.3 N.m (11.5 lb in). For either style of TPM sensor see the service parts guide for the correct GM part numbers to order and use. Disclaimer Locations Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Locations Engine Controls Component Views Upper Left Side of the Engine 1 - Fuel Injector 1 2 - Evaporative Emission (EVAP) Canister Purge Solenoid 3 - Fuel Injector 3 4 Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor 5 - Fuel Injector 5 6 - Fuel Injector 7 7 - Engine 8 Ignition Coil 7 9 - Ignition Coil 5 10 - Ignition Coil Harness 11 - C109 12 - Ignition Coil 3 13 - Ignition Coil 1 Page 3741 - JST connectors have JST in small letters on their connectors, similar to that above. The location of the logo will vary with the connector size and style. - Kostel has an "LK" with a circle around it. These connector are usually used as a transmissions connection and are currently use on some Cadillac vehicles. Page 7147 Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids Arrows and Symbols Arrows and Symbols This Service Data uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations. Arrows and Symbols 1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow Basic Knowledge Required GENERAL ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures contained in the service manual. You should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current (amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram, as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. Decimal and Metric Equivalents Decimal and Metric Equivalents Page 4518 Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. FCI Connectors FCI CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 6815 Tighten Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb in). Note The repair area MUST BE properly refinished to maintain a secure, stable and corrosion-free electrical ground. 12. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and Repair in SI. 13. Verify proper system operation. M8 Weld Nut Caution Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground repair. 1. If the M8 weld nut electrical ground location is accessible from both sides of the panel, a M8 conductive bolt and a M8 conductive nut may be used to secure the electrical ground wire terminal. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 2. Select a location adjacent the M8 weld nut having 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance behind the panel surface and 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance surrounding the new electrical ground site. 3. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the surface surrounding the ground location and allow to dry. Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled. 4. Drill a 10 mm (0.40 in) diameter hole through the panel. 5. Remove paint and primer from the area surrounding the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole until bare metal is visible. 6. Select a M8 conductive bolt. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 7. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M8 conductive bolt. Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase. 8. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground wire terminal. 9. Install the electrical ground wire terminal and the M8 conductive bolt to the ground location. 10. Select a M8 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 11. Install the M8 conductive nut to the bolt and: Tighten Tighten to 22 Nm (16 lb ft). Note The repair area MUST BE properly refinished to maintain a secure, stable and corrosion-free electrical ground. 12. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and Repair in SI. 13. Verify proper system operation. M8 Weld Nut Alternative Repair Caution Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground repair. 1. If the M8 weld nut electrical ground location is not accessible from both sides of the panel, a M6 conductive rivet stud and a M6 conductive nut may be used to secure the electrical ground wire terminal. 2. Select a location adjacent the damaged M8 weld nut having 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance behind the panel surface and 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance surrounding the M6 conductive rivet stud flange. 3. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the repair site and allow to dry. Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled. 4. Drill a 10 mm (0.40 in) diameter hole through the panel. Page 6993 6. Engage the sliding latch fastening the BCM to the rear electrical center. Slide the latch outboard until the locking tab (1) is fully seated. 7. Install the rear electrical center cover. 8. If replacing the BCM on a Chevrolet TrailBlazer or GMC Envoy, position the left hand second seat to a passenger position. 9. If replacing the BCM on a Chevrolet TrailBlazer EXT or GMC Envoy XL, install the left second row seat. 10. Connect the negative battery cable. 11. If installing a replacement BCM, program the BCM. Refer to Control Module References. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Page 8658 - A control module from another vehicle is installed. - Revised software/calibration files have been released for this vehicle. - IMPORTANT: DO NOT re-program the control module with the SAME software/calibration files that are already present in the control module. This is not an effective repair for any type of concern. Verify that the control module contains the correct software/calibration. If incorrect programming is found, reprogram the control module with the most current software/calibration. Refer to Control Module References for replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Testing for Short to Ground TESTING FOR SHORT TO GROUND NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 4. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit. With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is a short to ground in the circuit. Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2. Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). - When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. - If the DMM does not display voltage 4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is shorted. Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A DIGITAL MULTIMETER NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the powertrain control module (PCM), should only be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200 Digital Multimeter (DMM). The J 39200 instruction manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminage even though voltage is present. The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity. IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading. Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the measurement. Page 2693 5. Install the seat cushion foam pad and cover to the frame. 6. Install the seat belt buckle assembly (1) through the seat cushion pad. 7. Install the seat belt buckle assembly (1) to the seat adjuster with the bolt (2). Tighten the seat belt buckle bolt to 55 N.m (41 lb ft). 8. Connect the seat belt buckle electrical connector (1). 9. Connect the wiring harness (2) to the seat position switch. 10. Position the seat back assembly on the seat cushion assembly. Page 1780 The engine harness may be repaired using the J-38125. High Temperature Wiring Repairs HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperatures, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time may use materials i.e. wires, connectors, and shielding that has a higher heat rating than typical wiring. When making a repair in a high temperature area observe the following: Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature to replace any damaged wire. - Replace any heat shielding that is removed. - Cover any DuraSeal splice sleeves with SCT1 shrink tubing (available in the J-38125 Terminal Repair kit). - After making a wiring repair, ensure that the location of the wiring is not moved closer to the heat source. IDENTIFYING HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperature, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time need special considerations when making wiring repairs. Areas that may be exposed to higher temperatures can be identified by heat resistant materials that are being used in those areas. These materials may include heat reflective tape, moon tape, and high temperature shrink tubing. Also conduit and other protective coverings may be used. Because conduit or similar coverings are used throughout the vehicle regardless of the temperature, it may be necessary for the technician to determine if an area is exposed to excessive heat before making a wiring repair. Obvious areas of consideration would be any area located near the exhaust manifolds, catalytic converter, and exhaust pipes. The J-38125 contains much of the material you will need to perform repairs on areas exposed to high heat. The kit contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves to crimp and seal connections - High temperature SCT1 shrink tubing to protect the splice sleeves - A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct crimp tool to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools to remove the terminals from the connectors The J-38125 does not contain wire that is suitable to high temperature exposure. Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature of the same or larger gage size as the original wire when repair damage wire. Also replace any reflective tape that you remove during the repair. HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature rating of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125 and then encapsulate the splice sleeve using the high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the order listed. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip keeping all of the wire strands intact. Page 3288 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. 4. Remove the dress cover by using a flat bladed tool to release the dress cover locking tabs and lift up on the dress cover. 5. Cut the tie wrap that holds the wires to the connector body. Page 6539 difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Bosch Connectors (ECM) BOSCH CONNECTORS (ECM) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the assist lever on the top of the connector. Move the assist lever to the forward position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 5498 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches, and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original. - The wires insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the possibility of fuel contact. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1). 5. Select the proper duraseal splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool. Refer to the Crimp and Seal Splice Table. 6. Place the duraseal splice sleeve in the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115) crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 7. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to hold the duraseal splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 8. Insert the wires into the duraseal splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel in order to prevent the wire from passing through the splice (3). 9. Close the handles of the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115), until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is applied to the splice sleeve. 10. Shrink the insulation around the splice. - Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. - Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Splicing Inline Harness Diodes SPLICING INLINE HARNESS DIODES Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure. 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode. 2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool. 5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode. Page 3293 5. Once the nose piece retainers are relaxed, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should raise slightly. 6. On the opposite side of the nose piece, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should release completely. If the nose piece does not come off, repeat the procedure on the opposite side. Page 1490 4. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the rear of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. 5. Once the locking tabs are unlocked, slide the inner connector out of the rear of the connector housing. Page 6650 Page 222 4. Use a small flat-blade tool to slide the terminal position assurance (TPA) up one notch on both ends of the connector. The TPA is located underneath the wire dress cover. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 5701 TERMINAL REMOVAL Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors. 1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA) device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1). 3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 4. Gently pull the cable and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector. 5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal, refer to Terminal Repair. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3. Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector. REINSTALLING TERMINAL 1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly, refer to Wiring Repairs. 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3. Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) DELPHI CONNECTORS (WEATHER PACK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 6658 vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide variety of actions, including: - Wiggling the harness - Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting - Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector - Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation - Relocating a harness or wires All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. Another option is, with the component commanded ON and OFF by the scan tool, move related connectors and wiring and observe the component operation. With the engine running, move related connectors and wiring while monitoring engine operation. If harness or connector movement affects the data displayed, component/system operation, or engine operation, inspect and repair the harness/connections as necessary. You may need to load the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these cases you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide good results as well. There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions, along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the circuit to these kinds of conditions. SALT WATER SPRAY Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture. Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5 percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously. HIGH TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070. Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault condition. The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis. This option does not allow for the same control, however. LOW TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect. If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to -18°C (0°F) from one end and +71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized cooling needs. Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or components in an effort to duplicate the concern. DUPLICATING FAILURE CONDITIONS - If none of the previous tests are successful, attempt to duplicate and/or capture the failure conditions. Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, where applicable, contains the conditions that were present when the DTC set. 1. Review and record Freeze Frame/Failure Records data. 2. Clear the DTCs using the scan tool. 3. Turn the key to OFF and wait 15 seconds. 4. Operate the vehicle under the same conditions that were noted in Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, as closely as possible. The vehicle must also be operating within the Conditions for Running the DTC. Refer to Conditions for Running the DTC in the supporting text if a DTC is being diagnosed. 5. Monitor DTC Status for the DTC being tested. The scan tool will indicate Ran, when the enabling conditions have been satisfied long enough for the DTC to run. The scan tool will also indicate whether the DTC passed or failed. - An alternate method is to drive the vehicle with the DMM connected to a suspected circuit. An abnormal reading on the DMM when the concern occurs, may help you locate the concern. Measuring Frequency Page 7400 6. Gently pry the plastic terminal retainer down and carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (16-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, pull the two connector halves apart. Page 3144 - Support the GM Oil Life System, thereby minimizing the replacement of engine oil, before its life has been depleted. - Reduce the duplication of requirements for a large number of internal GM engine oil specifications. International Lubricants Standardization and Approval Committee (ILSAC) GF-5 Standard In addition to GM dexos 1(TM), a new International Lubricants Standardization and Approval Committee (ILSAC) standard called GF-5, was introduced in October 2010. - There will be a corresponding API category, called: SN Resource Conserving. The current GF-4 standard was put in place in 2004 and will become obsolete in October 2011. Similar to dexos 1(TM), the GF-5 standard will use a new fuel economy test, Sequence VID, which demands a statistically significant increase in fuel economy versus the Sequence VIB test that was used for GF-4. - It is expected that all dexos 1(TM) approved oils will be capable of meeting the GF-5 standard. However, not all GF-5 engine oils will be capable of meeting the dexos 1(TM) specification. - Like dexos(TM), the new ILSAC GF-5 standard will call for more sophisticated additives. The API will begin licensing marketers during October 2010, to produce and distribute GF-5 certified products, which are expected to include SAE 0W-20, 0W-30, 5W-20, 5W-30 and 10W-30 oils. Corporate Average Fuel Economy (CAFE) Requirements Effect on Fuel Economy Since CAFE standards were first introduced in 1974, the fuel economy of cars has more than doubled, while the fuel economy of light trucks has increased by more than 50 percent. Proposed CAFE standards call for a continuation of increased fuel economy in new cars and trucks. To meet these future requirements, all aspects of vehicle operation are being looked at more critically than ever before. New technology being introduced in GM vehicles designed to increase vehicle efficiency and fuel economy include direct injection, cam phasing, turbocharging and active fuel management (AFM). The demands of these new technologies on engine oil also are taken into consideration when determining new oil specifications. AFM for example can help to achieve improved fuel economy. However alternately deactivating and activating the cylinders by not allowing the intake and exhaust valves to open contributes to additional stress on the engine oil. Another industry trend for meeting tough fuel economy mandates has been a shift toward lower viscosity oils. dexos 1(TM) will eventually be offered in several viscosity grades in accordance with engine needs: SAE 0W-20, 5W-20, 0W-30 and 5W-30. Using the right viscosity grade oil is critical for proper engine performance. Always refer to the Maintenance section of a vehicle Owner Manual for the proper viscosity grade for the engine being serviced. GM Oil Life System in Conjunction With dexos (TM) Supports Extended Oil Change Intervals To help conserve oil while maintaining engine protection, many GM vehicles are equipped with the GM Oil Life System. This system can provide oil change intervals that exceed the traditional 3,000 mile (4,830 km) recommendation. The dexos (TM) specification, with its requirements for improved oil robustness, compliments the GM Oil Life System by supporting extended oil change intervals over the lifetime of a vehicle. If all GM customers with GM Oil Life System equipped vehicles would use the system as intended, GM estimates that more than 100 million gallons of oil could be saved annually. GM dexos 2(TM) Information Center Website Refer to the following General Motors website for dexos 2(TM) information about the different licensed brands that are currently available: http://www.gmdexos.com GM dexos 2(TM) Engine Oil Trademark and Icons Page 897 Open the harness by removing any tape. 2. Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. 3. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 4. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent american wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 5. Slide a section of high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing down the length of wire to be spliced. Ensure that the shrink tubing will not interfere with the splice procedure. 6. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 7. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. 8. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 9. Insert the wire into the DuraSeal splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 10. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Page 6230 Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. FCI Connectors FCI CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 5160 Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested: - Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. - Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a component or to other harnesses. - If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A TEST LAMP TOOLS REQUIRED J 35616-200 Test Light - Probe Kit NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminate even though voltage is present. The J 35616-200 is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair of leads. To properly operate this tool use the following procedures. When testing for voltage: 1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested. When testing for ground: 1. Attach one lead to battery positive voltage. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where ground should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is ground at the point being tested. Using Connector Test Adapters USING CONNECTOR TEST ADAPTERS NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Using Fused Jumper Wires USING FUSED JUMPER WIRES TOOLS REQUIRED J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged. The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested. AFL/ECP Connectors AFL/EPC CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 6246 5. Once the nose piece retainers are relaxed, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should raise slightly. 6. On the opposite side of the nose piece, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should release completely. If the nose piece does not come off, repeat the procedure on the opposite side. Page 1980 difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Bosch Connectors (ECM) BOSCH CONNECTORS (ECM) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the assist lever on the top of the connector. Move the assist lever to the forward position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 7162 View of connector in released position. 4. Disconnect the connector from the component. 5. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Release the rear lower half of the wiredress cover. Page 2232 4. Once the front 2 locks are unlocked, lift the front of the dress cover and pull it forward. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the small slot on the TPA and pushing down until the TPA releases. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to angle or rock the J 38125-21 tool when inserting it into the connector or the tool may break. Insert the J 38125-21 (GM P/N 15381651-2) tool into the round canal between the terminals cavities at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to repair Micro 64 connector terminals. The Micro 64 connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-64 (M jaw) was developed to crimp Micro 64 terminals. The J 38125-64 crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. The J 38125-64 crimping tool is also designed to crimp both the wire and the insulation at the same time. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro 64 terminals. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. 1. Cut the wire as close to the damaged terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. Page 7921 For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to refer to the table above. Disclaimer Page 1362 4. Slide the dress cover forward and off of the connector. 5. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front and rear of the connector. Page 6657 Checking Aftermarket Accessories CHECKING AFTERMARKET ACCESSORIES Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits: - CAUTION: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol. - NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice. OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol. Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the cause of the problems. Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include: Power feeds connected to points other than the battery - Antenna location - Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring - Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line - Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories. Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions INDUCING INTERMITTENT FAULT CONDITIONS TOOLS REQUIRED J 25070 Heat Gun Many intermittent open or shorted circuits are affected by harness/connector movement that is caused by vibration, engine torque, bumps/rough pavement, etc. In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness if the malfunction appears to be Page 1131 Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under the 5 year / 100,000 mile (160,000 km) emission warranty, use: Warranty Information (Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 8124 MEASURING FREQUENCY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal. IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM to autorange to an appropriate range. 1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency measured. Measuring Voltage MEASURING VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit. 1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods: - Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. - Turn ON the engine. - Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls. - Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested. 3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The DMM displays the voltage measured at that point. Measuring Voltage Drop MEASURING VOLTAGE DROP NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points. Probing Electrical Connectors PROBING ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS Page 2069 Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Diagrams Engine Controls Connector End Views Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor Page 7841 5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape. Seat Belt Schematic Icons Seat Belt Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons Page 1484 5. Once the nose piece retainers are relaxed, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should raise slightly. 6. On the opposite side of the nose piece, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should release completely. If the nose piece does not come off, repeat the procedure on the opposite side. Page 5513 Service and Repair Fluid Filter - A/T: Service and Repair Automatic Transmission Fluid and Filter Replacement Removal Procedure Caution: When the transmission is at operating temperatures, take necessary precautions when removing the drain plug, to avoid being burned by draining fluid. 1. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 2. Remove the catalytic converter. Refer to Catalytic Converter Replacement (4.2L Engine) Catalytic Converter Replacement (5.3L and 6.0L Engines). 3. Place a drain pan under the transmission oil pan. 4. Remove the oil pan drain plug, if equipped. 5. If necessary, remove the bolts and position aside the range selector cable bracket for clearance while lowering the pan. It is not necessary to remove the cable from the lever or bracket. 6. Remove the oil pan bolts from the front and sides of the pan only. 7. Loosen the rear oil pan bolts approximately 4 turns. 8. Lightly tap the oil pan with a rubber mallet in order to loosen the pan to allow the fluid to drain. 9. Remove the remaining oil pan bolts. 10. Remove the oil pan and the gasket. Page 7673 5. While pushing the terminal forward, insert the J 38125-24 in the release cavity above the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (43-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Page 6746 6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias. Reference the appropriate service manual wiring schematic to obtain the correct diode installation position. 7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for the soldering equipment. 8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed. 9. IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode attachment points with tape. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape. Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable SPLICING TWISTED OR SHIELDED CABLE Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable. 1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splice is made. 3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire. Staggering the splices by 65 mm (2.5 in) is recommended. 4. IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical contact with the drain wire. Re-assemble the cable. Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape. - Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1). - Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire. - Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape. Page 8595 If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the DuraSeal splice sleeves. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: - Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. - Do not use the crimp and DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 to crimp DuraSeal splice sleeve. In order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 4920 The first connector design of the Micro-Pack 100W (1) has a white connector interface that holds the terminals. The second design of the Micro-Pack 100W (2) has a gray interface to hold the terminals. Also, the first design has terminal cavities that are further apart (3 mm centerline) and offset from the other row of terminal cavities in the connector. The second design has terminals cavities that are closer together (2.54 mm centerline) and aligned vertically. One other way to identify the second design is the thin strip of material that runs along the outside of the cavities. IMPORTANT: There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W terminals which are very similar. Ensure that you have the correct terminal before crimping the new terminal to the wire. The first design connector uses the longer terminal (1) that has a raised area in front of the recess in the terminal. The second design connector uses the shorter terminal without the raised area. Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro-Pack 100W connectors. Some Micro-Pack 100W connector disassembly procedures will vary. Use this procedure as a guide. 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 8146 - In some cases Delphi will actually be printed on the connector. If Delphi is not printed on the connector, look for PED. In both cases there is no specific orientation for Delphi or PED and they can appear anywhere on the connector. - FCI connectors may have the FCI logo on their connectors. The logo is the letters FCI with an "A" above it. - JAE connector have JAE in small letters on their connectors. Page 8405 Depress the locks that are located on both sides of the wiredress cover and pull the lever over and past the locks. View of the connector when released from the component. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the front of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool push down on one of the locking tabs and pull the cover up until the dress cover releases. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. Page 6080 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. 4. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front of the connector. Page 1568 Refer to the following table as a guide in selecting the correct test adapter for front probing connectors: Backprobe IMPORTANT: Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures. - Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector. - Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large of a test probe. - After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected, test for proper terminal contact. Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the connector. Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure SCAN TOOL SNAPSHOT PROCEDURE Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used Page 2317 to analyze the data during the time a vehicle condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a trigger point that you have determined. Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2 snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a first-in, first-out basis. If a third snapshot is taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost. Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types: Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice - Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200 frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not lost if the Scan Tool is powered down. The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis. The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected values by plotting 3 parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful, especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC. Testing for a Short to Voltage TESTING FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4. Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt, there is a short to voltage in the circuit. Testing for Continuity TESTING FOR CONTINUITY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6. Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit. 7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity. With a Test Lamp IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits. 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6. If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity. Testing for Electrical Intermittents TESTING FOR ELECTRICAL INTERMITTENTS Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment. - Testing for Short to Ground - Testing for Continuity - Testing for a Short to Voltage Page 5450 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) and slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. Page 7396 5. While pushing the terminal forward, insert the J 38125-24 in the release cavity above the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (43-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Page 4184 18. Connect the MAF/IAT sensor electrical connector (1). 19. Install the air cleaner outlet duct. Refer to Air Cleaner Resonator Outlet Duct Replacement. 20. Install the fuel fill cap. 21. Connect the negative battery cable. Refer to Battery Negative Cable Disconnection and Connection. 22. Use the following procedure in order to inspect for leaks: 1. Turn the ignition ON, with the engine OFF, for 2 seconds. 2. Turn the ignition OFF for 10 seconds. 3. Turn the ignition ON, with the engine OFF. 4. Inspect for fuel leaks. Page 5679 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. 4. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front of the connector. Page 2638 The engine harness may be repaired using the J-38125. High Temperature Wiring Repairs HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperatures, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time may use materials i.e. wires, connectors, and shielding that has a higher heat rating than typical wiring. When making a repair in a high temperature area observe the following: Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature to replace any damaged wire. - Replace any heat shielding that is removed. - Cover any DuraSeal splice sleeves with SCT1 shrink tubing (available in the J-38125 Terminal Repair kit). - After making a wiring repair, ensure that the location of the wiring is not moved closer to the heat source. IDENTIFYING HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperature, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time need special considerations when making wiring repairs. Areas that may be exposed to higher temperatures can be identified by heat resistant materials that are being used in those areas. These materials may include heat reflective tape, moon tape, and high temperature shrink tubing. Also conduit and other protective coverings may be used. Because conduit or similar coverings are used throughout the vehicle regardless of the temperature, it may be necessary for the technician to determine if an area is exposed to excessive heat before making a wiring repair. Obvious areas of consideration would be any area located near the exhaust manifolds, catalytic converter, and exhaust pipes. The J-38125 contains much of the material you will need to perform repairs on areas exposed to high heat. The kit contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves to crimp and seal connections - High temperature SCT1 shrink tubing to protect the splice sleeves - A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct crimp tool to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools to remove the terminals from the connectors The J-38125 does not contain wire that is suitable to high temperature exposure. Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature of the same or larger gage size as the original wire when repair damage wire. Also replace any reflective tape that you remove during the repair. HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature rating of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125 and then encapsulate the splice sleeve using the high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the order listed. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip keeping all of the wire strands intact. Page 866 View of typical connector. View of connector in released position. 1. Locate the assist lever at the back of the connector. Move the assist lever to the rear position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the dress cover. Page 496 Depress the locks that are located on both sides of the wiredress cover and pull the lever over and past the locks. View of the connector when released from the component. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the front of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool push down on one of the locking tabs and pull the cover up until the dress cover releases. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. Page 224 2. Locate the two indents of the terminal position assurance (TPA) located on the bottom of the connector body. Page 8448 6. Gently pry the plastic terminal retainer down and carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (16-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, pull the two connector halves apart. Page 1625 9. The illustration shows a cutaway view of the connector to aid the technician in releasing the terminal retainer. 10. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Terminal Position Assurance Locks TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Tyco/Amp Connectors (CM 42-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (CM 42-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the connector body and pull the CPA out. The CPA is on the wire harness side of connector. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 5258 8. If replacement of the ECM/TCM bracket is required, remove the TCM. 9. Remove the ECM/TCM bracket retaining bolts (2). 10 Remove the ECM/TCM bracket (1) from the vehicle frame. Installation Procedure 1. If the ECM/TCM bracket (1) was previously removed, install the ECM/TCM bracket (1) to the vehicle frame. 2. Install the ECM/TCM bracket retaining bolts (2). Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 3. Tighten the ECM/TCM bracket bolts. Tighten the bolts to 10 N.m (89 lb in). 4. Install the TCM. Page 3784 2. Use a small flat-bladed tool to release the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting the tool in the small recess on the side of the connector and pushing up until the TPA releases from the connector body. The TPA should raise just slightly. Do not try to remove the TPA. IMPORTANT: The TPA on this connector cannot be removed unless the terminals are removed first. The TPA will come out of the connector body, but only slightly. When the TPA is slightly raised the terminals can be removed. Using excessive force to remove the TPA with the terminals still in the connector will damage the connector. 3. Repeat the process for the other side of the connector. 4. Ensure that the TPA is in the proper position to remove the terminals. Page 1628 2. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 8948 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Locations Windshield Washer Fluid Reservoir Page 4956 5. While pushing the terminal forward, insert the J 38125-24 in the release cavity above the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (43-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Page 98 monitor the Tech2(R) for the current time and date. REMINDER - Keep in mind that the time displayed on the Tech2(R) is in Greenwich Mean Time (GMT) and the offset is based on the time zones relationship to GMT. If replacement of the VIU/VCIM is necessary, you MUST reconfigure the OnStar® system. Failure to reconfigure the system will result in an additional customer visit for repair. OnStar® VIU, Generations 2 and 3, will require the technician to press the blue OnStar® button to reconfigure the vehicle with an OnStar® advisor. OnStar(R) VCIM, Generations 4-7 will require the technician to reconfigure the vehicle with the use of the TIS2WEB and SPS applications (pass thru only), along with the Tech2(R). The configuration and set-up procedure is a two-step process that must be completed step-by-step without interruption or delay in between each step. This procedure enables an automated activation without a button press by the technician to the OnStar(R) Call Center. Following this procedure, it may take up to 24 hours for all OnStar(R) services to be fully activated. How to Order Parts If the OnStar(R) GPS date/time stamp is non-recoverable and the unit needs to be replaced, dealers in the U.S. should contact Autocraft Electronics select the catalog item that contains this bulletin number. Canadian dealers should contact MASS Electronics. Dealers DO NOT need to call the GM Technical Assistance Center (TAC) for replacement approval. Autocraft Electronics and MASS Electronics will be responsible for verifying that the subject vehicle is a candidate for a replacement VIU/VCIM. Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models) Page 262 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the DuraSeal splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of a connector. CPAs are used in all SIR System connectors and also in some connectors of other systems. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals of a connection. TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE CLIPS IMPORTANT: When making a splice in an area that may be exposed to moisture use a crimp and seal splice sleeve instead of a Splice Clip. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. Page 1304 Page 5738 View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. 4. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers CIRCUIT PROTECTION - CIRCUIT BREAKERS A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types of circuit Page 4644 5. Once the nose piece retainers are relaxed, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should raise slightly. 6. On the opposite side of the nose piece, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should release completely. If the nose piece does not come off, repeat the procedure on the opposite side. Page 5308 5. Insert the J 38125-557 (GM P/N 12122378) into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 6. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Connector Position Assurance Locks CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of the connector. CPAs are used in various connectors throughout the vehicle. CPAs are also used in all SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals, of the connector. Connector Repairs CONNECTOR REPAIRS Procedures Fluid - Differential: Procedures Rear Axle Lubricant Level Inspection (9.5 LD Inch Axle) Rear Axle Lubricant Level Inspection (9.5 LD Inch Axle) Important: All axle assemblies are filled by volume of fluid during production. They are not filled to reach a certain level. When checking the fluid level on any axle, variations in the readings can be caused by factory fill differences between the minimum and the maximum fluid volume. Also, if a vehicle has just been driven before checking the fluid level, it may appear lower than normal because the fluid has traveled out along the axle tubes and has not drained back to the sump area. Therefore, a reading taken five minutes after the vehicle has been driven will appear to have a lower fluid level than a vehicle that has been stationary for an hour or two. Remember that the rear axle assembly must be supported to get a true reading. 1. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 2. Ensure the vehicle is level. 3. Inspect the rear axle for leaks. Repair as necessary. 4. Clean the area around the rear axle fill plug. 5. Remove the rear axle fill plug. 6. Inspect the lubricant level. The lubricant level should be between 0-10 mm (0.00-1.57 in) below the fill plug opening for the 9.5 inch LD axle. 7. If the level is low, add lubricant until the level is even with the bottom edge of the fill plug opening. Use the proper fluid. Refer to Fluid and Lubricant Recommendations. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 8. Install the rear axle fill plug. Tighten the rear axle fill plug to 33 N.m (24 lb ft). 9. Lower the vehicle. Rear Axle Lubricant Level Inspection (8.0/8.6 Inch Axle) Rear Axle Lubricant Level Inspection (8.0/8.6 Inch Axle) 1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 2. Make sure the vehicle is level. Page 8701 4. Slide the dress cover forward and off of the connector. 5. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front and rear of the connector. Page 5189 TERMINAL REMOVAL Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors. 1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA) device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1). 3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 4. Gently pull the cable and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector. 5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal, refer to Terminal Repair. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3. Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector. REINSTALLING TERMINAL 1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly, refer to Wiring Repairs. 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3. Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) DELPHI CONNECTORS (WEATHER PACK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 6334 2. Locate the nose piece locking tabs that are positioned on the side of the connector nose piece. The connector nose piece acts as a terminal positive assurance (TPA) and may be referred to as such. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to push in one of the locking tabs while gently pulling on the same side of the nose piece. 4. Repeat the procedure for the other locking tab and remove the nose piece. 5. Remove the wire dress cover. The following is a general procedure for wire dress cover removal. Use this procedure as a guide, some dress cover removal procedures may vary. 6. Use fingers to squeeze the 2 locking legs of the cover. Page 2139 4. Slide the dress cover forward and off of the connector. 5. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front and rear of the connector. Page 5478 2. Use a small flat-bladed tool to release the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting the tool in the small recess on the side of the connector and pushing up until the TPA releases from the connector body. The TPA should raise just slightly. Do not try to remove the TPA. IMPORTANT: The TPA on this connector cannot be removed unless the terminals are removed first. The TPA will come out of the connector body, but only slightly. When the TPA is slightly raised the terminals can be removed. Using excessive force to remove the TPA with the terminals still in the connector will damage the connector. 3. Repeat the process for the other side of the connector. 4. Ensure that the TPA is in the proper position to remove the terminals. Page 3402 4. Slide the dress cover forward and off of the connector. 5. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front and rear of the connector. Page 2462 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Ensure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the Terminal Removal Procedure. Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PULL TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL If the terminal is visibly damaged or is suspected of having a faulty connection, the terminal should be replaced. Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors: 1. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) device and/or the secondary lock. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component or separate the connectors for in-line connectors. 3. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device. 4. Insert the proper pick or removal tool into the front of the connector body. 5. IMPORTANT: On connectors with more than one terminal the service loop may not be large enough to remove the terminal and crimp on a new one. If the terminal wire does not have a large enough service loop for removal, cut the wire 5 cm (2 in) behind the connector before removal. Grasp the wire at the back of the connector body and gently push the terminal out the front of the connector body. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. If the wire needed to be cut in order to remove the terminal, gently push a small length of the same size wire through the back of the connector cavity until there is enough wire exposed in order to crimp on a new terminal. If the wire was not cut, cut the existing wire as close to the old terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 4. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. TERMINAL INSTALLATION 1. Align the terminal and pull the wire from the back of the connector in order to seat the terminal. 2. If necessary, cut the new wire to proper length and splice with existing circuit. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. 3. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply dielectric grease to the connector. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PUSH TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 755 View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. 4. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers CIRCUIT PROTECTION - CIRCUIT BREAKERS A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types of circuit Page 4018 7. Remove the 3 frame engine mount bracket retaining bolts. 8. Install a pole jack underneath the oil pan. 9. Insert a block of wood between the oil pan and the pole jack. Page 8964 6. Gently pry the plastic terminal retainer down and carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (16-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, pull the two connector halves apart. Page 8005 5. Insert the J 38125-557 (GM P/N 12122378) into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 6. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Connector Position Assurance Locks CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of the connector. CPAs are used in various connectors throughout the vehicle. CPAs are also used in all SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals, of the connector. Connector Repairs CONNECTOR REPAIRS Page 4092 Allow at least a two hour soak time between engine OFF and start up when evaluating the tick noise. 2. Start the engine and evaluate the valve lifter tick noise. ‹› If the valve lifter tick noise is still present, replace all 16 valve lifters. Refer to Valve Lifter Replacement in SI. Parts Information Note A V8 AFM engine requires 8 AFM lifters and 8 non-AFM lifters for a total of 16 lifters. Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use: Warranty Information (Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 6233 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. JST Connectors JST CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, remove the connector from the component. Page 7650 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. JST Connectors JST CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, remove the connector from the component. Page 4907 11. Insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) into the 2 triangular cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 12. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE 1. Prior to installation the terminal must be aligned so the (1) coding lugs align with the (2) coding grooves on the connector. 2. Once the terminal is aligned, slide the terminal into the cavity until the retainer has engaged in the cavity of the connector. 3. Slide the TPA in the connector body and seat it using a small flat bladed tool. The TPA is seated when it is flush with the contact housing. 4. Secure the wires to the connector body using a tie wrap and replace the dress cover and grommet. Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) BOSCH CONNECTORS (2.8 JPT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Pull out the slider on the connector position assurance (CPA) until it is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 3579 10. Align the inscribed mark on the tire with the valve stem on the wheel. 11. Reinstall the Tire Pressure Sensor. Refer to Tire Pressure Sensor installation procedure in SI. 12. Mount the tire on the wheel. Refer to Tire Mounting and Dismounting. 13. Pressurize the tire to 276 kPa (40 psi) and inspect for leaks. 14. Adjust tire pressure to meet the placard specification. 15. Balance the tire/wheel assembly. Refer to Tire and Wheel Assembly Balancing - Off-Vehicle. 16. Install the tire and wheel assembly onto the vehicle. Refer to the appropriate service procedure in SI. Parts Information Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models) Important The Silicone - Adhesive/Sealant comes in a case quantity of six. ONLY charge warranty one tube of adhesive/sealant per wheel repair. For vehicles repaired under warranty, use: One leak repair per wheel. Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table above. Disclaimer Page 2001 pulling it through. This will prevent damage to the internal seals of the connector. Once the terminal is pushed out of the connector, cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible and pull the wire through the connector. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE The Micro-Pack 100W connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool was developed to crimp Micro-Pack 100W terminals. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 2. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert the terminal into the crimp tool until the core wings are flush with the anvil on the crimp tool. Be sure that the wings are pointed toward the crimp tool former and release the spring locator. The locator will hold the terminal in place. Inspect the alignment of the terminal wings with the crimp tool former. If the terminal wings are wider than the crimp tool former, remove the terminal and bend the terminal wings in slightly. 5. Place stripped wire into terminal. 6. Crimp the new terminal to the wire. If a jam occurs, press the emergency release to open applicator. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire perform the following procedure in order to replace Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. Page 7414 11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the solder equipment. 12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. 13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to cover the first piece of tape. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE SLEEVES TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit IMPORTANT: Use only dura seal splice sleeves. Other splice sleeves may not protect the splice from moisture or provide a good electrical connection. Use duraseal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. Use duraseal splice sleeves where there is special requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire using duraseal splice sleeves. Page 7379 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the rear TPA from the connector. 7. IMPORTANT: The front TPA cannot be removed from the connector. Only move it to the release point. Use a small flat-blade tool to move the front TPA to the release position. 8. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 9. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Molex Connectors Page 8962 View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. View of the release tool being used for the smaller terminals. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (2-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 6353 MOLEX CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. 2. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. Page 1732 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert terminal into the appropriate terminal holder until it hits bottom and stops. The correct terminal holder is determined by the wire size. Also ensure that the terminals wings are pointing towards the former on the tool and the release locator. 5. Insert the stripped cable into the terminal. Insulation should be visible on both sides of the terminal insulation wings. 6. Compress the handles until the ratchet automatically releases. 7. Place the terminal into the appropriate cavity and assemble the connector. Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO-PACK 100W) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W connectors. These connectors are very similar but use different terminals and have some minor physical differences also. Page 8353 Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under the 5 year / 100,000 mile (160,000 km) emission warranty, use: Warranty Information (Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Specifications Drive Belt Tensioner: Specifications Drive Belt Tensioner Bolt ..................................................................................................................... ...................................................... 50 N.m (37 lb ft) Page 4028 Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 1. Install the engine mount bracket spacer if it has been replaced. Tighten the bolts to 50 N.m (37 lb ft). Important: Make sure that the cut out side of the engine mount shield is positioned away from the engine. 2. Install the engine mount to the upper engine mount bracket. Tighten the engine mount nuts to 50 N.m (37 lb ft). Page 4420 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. 4. Remove the dress cover by using a flat bladed tool to release the dress cover locking tabs and lift up on the dress cover. 5. Cut the tie wrap that holds the wires to the connector body. Page 5435 - JST connectors have JST in small letters on their connectors, similar to that above. The location of the logo will vary with the connector size and style. - Kostel has an "LK" with a circle around it. These connector are usually used as a transmissions connection and are currently use on some Cadillac vehicles. Page 4621 pulling it through. This will prevent damage to the internal seals of the connector. Once the terminal is pushed out of the connector, cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible and pull the wire through the connector. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE The Micro-Pack 100W connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool was developed to crimp Micro-Pack 100W terminals. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 2. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert the terminal into the crimp tool until the core wings are flush with the anvil on the crimp tool. Be sure that the wings are pointed toward the crimp tool former and release the spring locator. The locator will hold the terminal in place. Inspect the alignment of the terminal wings with the crimp tool former. If the terminal wings are wider than the crimp tool former, remove the terminal and bend the terminal wings in slightly. 5. Place stripped wire into terminal. 6. Crimp the new terminal to the wire. If a jam occurs, press the emergency release to open applicator. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire perform the following procedure in order to replace Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. Page 2607 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Kostal Connectors KOSTAL CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 925 Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models) Important Select the appropriate Labor Operation for the repair that is performed. For vehicles repaired under warranty, use: Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 7402 View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. 4. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers CIRCUIT PROTECTION - CIRCUIT BREAKERS A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types of circuit Page 2219 IMPORTANT: Ensure that the dress cover and connector body are both in the released position before reassembling. Failure to do so may cause damage to the connector and component. Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (0.64) BOSCH CONNECTORS (0.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While pressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock until the lever is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Pull the rubber boot that covers the wires back to expose the end of the connector dress cover. 4. Place the connector locking lever in the center of the connector. 5. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs that are on the wire end of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover and connector body and pry up. Page 5469 5. Once the nose piece retainers are relaxed, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should raise slightly. 6. On the opposite side of the nose piece, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should release completely. If the nose piece does not come off, repeat the procedure on the opposite side. Page 3654 Wheels: Description and Operation Replacement Wheels Description Replacement Wheels Description Replace the wheel if any of the following conditions exist: ^ The wheel exhibits excessive runout. ^ The wheel is bent. ^ The wheel is cracked. ^ The wheel is severely rusted. ^ The wheel is severely corroded. Important: Air leaks caused by porosity on aluminum wheels are repairable. ^ The wheel leaks air. Caution: If you are replacing the wheel(s), the wheel stud(s), the wheel nut(s) or the wheel bolt(s), install only new GM original equipment parts. Installation of used parts or non-GM original equipment parts may cause the wheel to loosen, loss of tire air pressure, poor vehicle handling and loss of vehicle control resulting in personal injury. Notice: The use of non-GM original equipment wheels may cause: ^ Damage to the wheel bearing, the wheel fasteners and the wheel ^ Tire damage caused by the modified clearance to the adjacent vehicle components ^ Adverse vehicle steering stability caused by the modified scrub radius ^ Damage to the vehicle caused by the modified ground clearance ^ Speedometer and odometer inaccuracy Replace the wheel, the wheel studs and the wheel/nuts, or the wheel bolts if applicable, if any of the following conditions exist: ^ The wheel has elongated bolt holes. ^ The wheel/nuts, or bolts if applicable, loosen repeatedly. Steel wheel identification is stamped into the wheel near the valve stem. Aluminum wheel identification is cast into the inboard side of the wheel. Page 3622 Important Other forms of slow air leaks are possible. If the body of the tire, valve stem and wheel flange show no signs of air seepage, refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 05-03-10-003D for additional information on possible wheel porosity issues. 3. Bead seat corrosion is identified by what appears like blistering of the wheel finish, causing a rough or uneven surface that is difficult for the tire to maintain a proper seal on. Below is a close-up photo of bead seat corrosion on an aluminum wheel that was sufficient to cause slow air loss. Close-Up of Bead Seat Corrosion 4. If corrosion is found on the wheel bead seat, measure the affected area as shown below. - For vehicles with 32,186 km (20,000 mi) or less, the total allowable combined linear area of repairable corrosion is 100 mm (4 in) or less. If the total area(s) of corrosion exceed these dimensions, the wheel should be replaced. - For vehicles that have exceeded 32,186 km (20,000 mi), the total allowable combined linear area of repairable corrosion is 200 mm (8 in) or less. If the total area(s) of corrosion exceed these dimensions, the wheel should be replaced. 5. In order to correct the wheel leak, use a clean-up (fine cut) sanding disc or biscuit to remove the corrosion and any flaking paint. You should remove the corrosion back far enough until you reach material that is stable and firmly bonded to the wheel. Try to taper the edge of any flaking paint as best you can in order to avoid sharp edges that may increase the chance of a leak reoccurring. The photo below shows an acceptable repaired surface. Notice Corrosion that extends up the lip of the wheel, where after the clean-up process it would be visible with the tire mounted, is only acceptable on the inboard flange. The inboard flange is not visible with the wheel assembly in the mounted position. If any loose coatings or corrosion extend to the visible surfaces on the FACE of the wheel, that wheel must be replaced. Important Remove ONLY the material required to eliminate the corrosion from the bead seating surface. DO NOT remove excessive amounts of material. ALWAYS keep the sealing surface as smooth and level as possible. Page 6465 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. 4. Remove the dress cover by using a flat bladed tool to release the dress cover locking tabs and lift up on the dress cover. 5. Cut the tie wrap that holds the wires to the connector body. Page 5879 The engine harness may be repaired using the J-38125. High Temperature Wiring Repairs HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperatures, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time may use materials i.e. wires, connectors, and shielding that has a higher heat rating than typical wiring. When making a repair in a high temperature area observe the following: Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature to replace any damaged wire. - Replace any heat shielding that is removed. - Cover any DuraSeal splice sleeves with SCT1 shrink tubing (available in the J-38125 Terminal Repair kit). - After making a wiring repair, ensure that the location of the wiring is not moved closer to the heat source. IDENTIFYING HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperature, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time need special considerations when making wiring repairs. Areas that may be exposed to higher temperatures can be identified by heat resistant materials that are being used in those areas. These materials may include heat reflective tape, moon tape, and high temperature shrink tubing. Also conduit and other protective coverings may be used. Because conduit or similar coverings are used throughout the vehicle regardless of the temperature, it may be necessary for the technician to determine if an area is exposed to excessive heat before making a wiring repair. Obvious areas of consideration would be any area located near the exhaust manifolds, catalytic converter, and exhaust pipes. The J-38125 contains much of the material you will need to perform repairs on areas exposed to high heat. The kit contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves to crimp and seal connections - High temperature SCT1 shrink tubing to protect the splice sleeves - A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct crimp tool to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools to remove the terminals from the connectors The J-38125 does not contain wire that is suitable to high temperature exposure. Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature of the same or larger gage size as the original wire when repair damage wire. Also replace any reflective tape that you remove during the repair. HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature rating of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125 and then encapsulate the splice sleeve using the high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the order listed. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip keeping all of the wire strands intact. Page 5347 7. The illustration above identifies the entry canal where the terminal release tool will be inserted, and the terminal cavity. - Terminal (1) - Entry Canal (2) 8. Insert the J-38125-553 (15315247) tool into the entry canal and pry up on the terminal retainer. The terminal retainer is a small plastic piece on the top of the terminal. The terminal retainer must be held up while the terminal is pulled out of the connector. Page 3924 5. Disconnect the fuel feed (1) and fuel return (2) pipes from the fuel rail. Refer to Metal Collar Quick Connect Fitting Service. 6. Disconnect the integral clip (3) from the wire harness bracket. 7. Remove the engine wire harness bracket bolt. 8. Position the engine electrical wire harness bracket with wires attached out of the way. 9. Remove the coolant heater cord from the heater (2). Important: Do not score the surface of the engine block hole when removing the coolant heater. 10. Remove the coolant heater from the block. Installation Procedure 1. Remove any burrs, sealer, paint or other foreign material from the threads/sealing surface of the engine block and from the old coolant heater if the heater is to be reused. 2. If reusing the old coolant heater, apply thread sealant GM P/N 12346004 (Canadian P/N 10953480), or equivalent to the threads. Page 6363 7. Pressing the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool in the release cavity of the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and crimper in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (DOOR MODULE) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Side view of connector. View of top of connector. 1. Locate the assist lever and lock on the top of the connector. Page 4867 5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape. Seat Belt Schematic Icons Seat Belt Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons Page 2773 8. Install the transmission fluid pressure switch. 9. Install but do not tighten the control valve body bolts which retain the transmission fluid pressure switch to the control valve body. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. Notice: Torque valve body bolts in a spiral pattern starting from the center. If the bolts are torqued at random, valve bores may be distorted and inhibit valve operation. 10. Tighten the control valve body bolts in a spiral pattern starting from the center, as indicated by the arrows. Tighten the control valve body bolts (in sequence) to 11 N.m (97 lb in). 11. Ensure that the manual detent spring is aligned properly with the detent lever. Tighten the manual detent spring bolt to 31 N.m (23 lb ft). Page 6268 Open the harness by removing any tape. 2. Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. 3. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 4. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent american wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 5. Slide a section of high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing down the length of wire to be spliced. Ensure that the shrink tubing will not interfere with the splice procedure. 6. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 7. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. 8. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 9. Insert the wire into the DuraSeal splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 10. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Page 4500 - JST connectors have JST in small letters on their connectors, similar to that above. The location of the logo will vary with the connector size and style. - Kostel has an "LK" with a circle around it. These connector are usually used as a transmissions connection and are currently use on some Cadillac vehicles. Page 5331 REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. The release tab is located on the top of the wiredress cover. View of connector in released position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Page 2043 If a wire is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm, etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except coaxial. - Do not use the DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent American wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 6201 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (BSK) BOSCH CONNECTORS (BSK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 3. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 4. Insert the J 38125-561 tool into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 5. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is Page 4704 Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under the 5 year / 100,000 mile (160,000 km) emission warranty, use: Warranty Information (Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 7981 Engine Control Module: Diagnostic Aids Arrows and Symbols Arrows and Symbols This Service Data uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations. Arrows and Symbols 1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow Basic Knowledge Required GENERAL ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures contained in the service manual. You should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current (amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram, as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. Decimal and Metric Equivalents Decimal and Metric Equivalents Page 3779 7. Pressing the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool in the release cavity of the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and crimper in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (DOOR MODULE) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Side view of connector. View of top of connector. 1. Locate the assist lever and lock on the top of the connector. Page 6801 Note The rivet stud and surrounding panel area MUST BE properly refinished PRIOR to the installation of the electrical ground wire terminal and conductive nut to maintain a secure, stable and corrosion-free electrical ground. 11. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and Repair in SI. 12. Allow the refinished repair area to cure sufficiently before removing the protective material applied to the rivet stud threads. 13. Remove the painters tape or equivalent from the rivet stud threads. 14. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, thoroughly clean the rivet stud threads to remove any adhesive and allow to dry. 15. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M6 conductive rivet stud. Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase. 16. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground wire terminal. 17. Install the electrical ground wire terminal to the M6 conductive rivet stud. 18. Select a M6 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 19. Install the M6 conductive nut to the rivet stud and: Tighten Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb in) 20. Verify proper system operation. Parts Information Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use: Warranty Information (Saab Models) Page 4939 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the rear TPA from the connector. 7. IMPORTANT: The front TPA cannot be removed from the connector. Only move it to the release point. Use a small flat-blade tool to move the front TPA to the release position. 8. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 9. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Molex Connectors Page 8684 2. Locate the nose piece locking tabs that are positioned on the side of the connector nose piece. The connector nose piece acts as a terminal positive assurance (TPA) and may be referred to as such. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to push in one of the locking tabs while gently pulling on the same side of the nose piece. 4. Repeat the procedure for the other locking tab and remove the nose piece. 5. Remove the wire dress cover. The following is a general procedure for wire dress cover removal. Use this procedure as a guide, some dress cover removal procedures may vary. 6. Use fingers to squeeze the 2 locking legs of the cover. Page 2053 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches, and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original. - The wires insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the possibility of fuel contact. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1). 5. Select the proper duraseal splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool. Refer to the Crimp and Seal Splice Table. 6. Place the duraseal splice sleeve in the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115) crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 7. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to hold the duraseal splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 8. Insert the wires into the duraseal splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel in order to prevent the wire from passing through the splice (3). 9. Close the handles of the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115), until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is applied to the splice sleeve. 10. Shrink the insulation around the splice. - Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. - Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Splicing Inline Harness Diodes SPLICING INLINE HARNESS DIODES Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure. 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode. 2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool. 5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode. Page 7191 Release the lower wiredress cover locking tab. Release the upper wiredress cover locking tab. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. Page 1774 2. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully push the terminal position assurance (TPA) towards the face of the connector on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA is fragile and may break if not done carefully. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. 3. Use the J 38125-215 tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Horn - Inoperative When Pressing Horn Pad Horn Switch: Customer Interest Horn - Inoperative When Pressing Horn Pad TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 07-08-54-001C Date: October 17, 2008 Subject: EI07279 - Horn Inoperative from Steering Wheel Horn Pad (Ground Path Repair Procedure) Models: 2006-2007 Buick Rainier 2006 Chevrolet TrailBlazer EXT 2006-2009 Chevrolet TrailBlazer 2006 GMC Envoy XL, Envoy XUV 2006-2009 GMC Envoy, Envoy Denali Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to provide field fix information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 07-08-54-001B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories). Condition Important: If the horn does NOT work from the key fob horn button, disregard this bulletin and proceed with diagnosis/repair according to SI. Some customers may comment that the horn is inoperative from the horn pad on the steering wheel. Cause The general cause of this condition is high resistance in the ground path through the steering column that energizes the horn relay. The key fob panic button uses a different ground path and is not affected. A number of locations in the circuit have been identified as sources of the high resistance. It is often difficult to pinpoint the specific location of the high resistance because the condition is usually intermittent. Attempting to discover the location can be frustrating because as circuit components are moved, the condition will often disappear. A few locations have been identified as frequent contributors to the problem. Correction Complete the following steps to diagnose and repair this condition: 1. Does the horn work by depressing the button(s) on the key fob? ^ Yes - proceed with step 2. ^ No - do not proceed with this bulletin. Diagnose and repair using information found in SI. 2. To aid in the diagnosis and to avoid disturbing others, disconnect the wiring harness from the horn assembly and insert appropriate connectors to monitor the voltage with a multi-meter or a test light. If the horn pad is currently working, rotate the steering wheel lock to lock while depressing the horn pad to determine if there are any spots in the rotation where the horn pad quits working. Caution: When performing service on or near the SIR components or the SIR wiring, the SIR system must be disabled. Refer to SIR Disabling and Enabling. Failure to observe the correct procedure could cause deployment of the SIR components, personal injury, or unnecessary SIR system Page 7726 For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 4136 11. Loosen the 2 upper air conditioning (A/C) compressor bracket bolts (4). 12. Remove the 2 lower A/C compressor bracket bolts (3). 13. Remove the 2 lower bellhousing bolts. Page 7852 Oxygen Sensor: Service Precautions Heated Oxygen Sensor Resistance Learn Reset Notice Heated Oxygen Sensor Resistance Learn Reset Notice Notice: When replacing the HO2S perform the following: * A code clear with a scan tool, regardless of whether or not a DTC is set * HO2S heater resistance learn reset with a scan tool, where available Perform the above in order to reset the HO2S resistance learned value and avoid possible HO2S failure. Page 7744 Page 6446 7. Apply pressure and gently rock the cover until one locking leg is unseated. 8. Continue to apply pressure and rock the cover until the second locking leg is unseated. Repeat procedure for the other side of the dress cover and remove the cover. 9. Use J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) to gently lift the terminal retaining tab while gently pulling the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 10. If the terminal is severely bent or damaged, it may be possible on some connectors to push the wire out of the front of the connector instead of Page 3353 MEASURING FREQUENCY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal. IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM to autorange to an appropriate range. 1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency measured. Measuring Voltage MEASURING VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit. 1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods: - Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. - Turn ON the engine. - Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls. - Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested. 3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The DMM displays the voltage measured at that point. Measuring Voltage Drop MEASURING VOLTAGE DROP NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points. Probing Electrical Connectors PROBING ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS Page 7936 Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate labor operation for the source of the water leak Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 4578 Page 6492 Open the harness by removing any tape. 2. Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. 3. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 4. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent american wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 5. Slide a section of high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing down the length of wire to be spliced. Ensure that the shrink tubing will not interfere with the splice procedure. 6. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 7. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. 8. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 9. Insert the wire into the DuraSeal splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 10. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Page 7607 IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals. Front probe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the connector. IMPORTANT: When probing female 0.64 terminals, it is important to use the correct adapter. There have been some revisions to the test adapter for 0.64 terminals. The proper adapter for 0.64 terminals is the J 35616-64B which has a gold terminal and a black wire between the base and tip. Failure to use the proper test adapter may result in damage to the terminal being tested and improper diagnosis. NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Page 3407 8. Insert the J 38125-213 into the small terminal release hole on the nose piece and gently pull on the back of the wire. 9. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Repairing Connector Terminals REPAIRING CONNECTOR TERMINALS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following: Push to Seat terminals - Pull to Seat terminals Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your terminal repair. The J-38125 contains further information. 1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.For cable seal terminals, remove the seal. 2. Apply the correct cable seal per gage size of the wire, if used.Slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation removal. 3. Remove the insulation. 4. For sealed terminals only, align the seal with the end of the cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal.For sealed terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal. 6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.For sealed terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable. 8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals excepting Micro-Pack 100.64 size. Soldering Micro-Pack 100 World terminals may damage the terminal. Sumitomo Connectors SUMITOMO CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 4675 5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape. Seat Belt Schematic Icons Seat Belt Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons Page 8033 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Kostal Connectors KOSTAL CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 1865 - Most Molex connectors will have the Molex logo on the dresscover of the connector. In some cases the connectors may have MX followed by another letter. The third letter indicates where the connector was made. A connector with MXD is a Molex connector made in Detroit. Sumitomo has a unique symbol on their connector and possibly a part number. The symbol is similar to that of a diamond lying on its side, similar to that shown. The logo could appear anywhere but the most common place is at the wire side of the housing. Tyco/AMP has many different and unique connector designs. Some may or may not have identifiable marks on them. Locations Crankshaft Position Sensor: Locations Engine Controls Component Views Lower Right Side of the Engine - Rear 1 - Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor 2 - Knock Sensor (KS) 2 - Right 3 - Engine Harness 4 Starter 5 - Engine Page 9051 4. Use a small flat-blade tool to slide the terminal position assurance (TPA) up one notch on both ends of the connector. The TPA is located underneath the wire dress cover. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 5393 Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Install the 3 APP sensor bolts (1). Tighten the bolts to 20 N.m (15 lb ft). 3. Connect the APP sensor electrical connector. 4. Verify that the vehicle meets the following conditions: * The vehicle is not in a reduced engine power mode. * The ignition is ON. * The engine is OFF. 5. Connect a scan tool in order to test for a proper throttle-opening and throttle-closing range. 6. Operate the accelerator pedal and monitor the throttle angles. The accelerator pedal should operate freely, without binding, between a closed throttle, and a wide open throttle. Page 8966 View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. 4. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers CIRCUIT PROTECTION - CIRCUIT BREAKERS A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types of circuit Page 3968 5. Apply threadlock to the threads of the bracket bolts. Refer to Sealers, Adhesives, and Lubricants for the correct part number. 6. If necessary, install the ignition coils and bracket to the rocker arm cover. 7. If necessary, install the ignition coil bracket studs to the rocker arm cover. Tighten the studs to 12 N.m (106 lb in). 8. Install the spark plug wires to the ignition coils. 9. Position the engine harness, if necessary. 10. Install the harness clips. 11. Connect the main electrical connector (5) to the ignition coil wire harness. 12. Install the CPA lock. Page 763 If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs SIR/SRS WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS, and the wiring components, such as connectors and terminals. IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system terminals. Use either an SIR/SRS pigtail or a terminated lead from the SIR Repair Kit Tray. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves, in order to repair the SIR/SRS wiring - A special crimping tool - A heat torch - An instruction manual The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides the necessary low resistance contact integrity for these sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors SIR/SRS CONNECTOR REPAIR (PLASTIC BODY AND TERMINAL METAL PIN) The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made with a special plating. This plating provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. Use the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit for repairing SIR/SRS terminals and connectors. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the repair kit. The J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit contains: Various terminated leads for sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) terminal replacement - Various connector positive assurance (CPA) locks for SIR/SRS connectors - Base of steering column pigtail connectors part number 12085514 - Yellow vinyl electrical tape Pigtail repair packs are available for SIR/SRS connectors with eight or less terminals. Only the connector body is available for connectors with more than eight terminals. The terminated leads in the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit can be used to replace damaged terminals when replacing the connector body. SIR/SRS COMPONENT WIRE PIGTAIL REPAIR IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails. A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device, not by a connector. If a wiring pigtail is damaged, you must replace the entire component, with pigtail. The inflatable restraint steering wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component. SIR/SRS WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 6464 MOLEX CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. 2. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. Specifications Crankshaft: Specifications Crankshaft Oil Deflector Nuts .............................................................................................................. ....................................................... 25 N.m (18 lb ft) Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor Bolt ...................................................................................................................................................... 25 N.m (18 lb ft) Crankshaft Rear Oil Seal Housing Bolts ..................................................................................................................................................... 30 N.m (22 lb ft) Crankshaft Main Journal Diameter Production ........................................................................................................................................... ...................... 64.992-65.008 mm (2.558-2.559 in) Service ................................................................ ............................................................................................................................. 64.992 mm (2.558 in) Crankshaft Main Journal Out-of-Round Production ........................................................................................................................................... ........................................ 0.003 mm (0.000118 in) Service ................................................................ ............................................................................................................................. 0.008 mm (0.0003 in) Crankshaft Main Journal Taper Production ........................................................................................................................................... .............................................. 0.01 mm (0.0004 in) Service ................................................................ ............................................................................................................................. 0.02 mm (0.00078 in) Crankshaft Rear Flange Runout .......................................................................................................... ..................................................... 0.05 mm (0.002 in) Crankshaft Reluctor Ring Runout - Measured 1.0 mm (0.04 in) Below Tooth Diameter .......................................................................... 0.7 mm (0.028 in) Crankshaft Thrust Surface Production ........................................................................................................................................... ........................ 26.14-26.22 mm (1.029-1.0315 in) Service ................................................................ ............................................................................................................................. 26.22 mm (1.0315 in) Crankshaft Thrust Surface Runout ........................................................................................................................................................... 0.025 mm 0.001 in Page 1791 US English/Metric Conversion US English/Metric Conversion Page 1514 6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias. Reference the appropriate service manual wiring schematic to obtain the correct diode installation position. 7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for the soldering equipment. 8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed. 9. IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode attachment points with tape. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape. Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable SPLICING TWISTED OR SHIELDED CABLE Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable. 1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splice is made. 3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire. Staggering the splices by 65 mm (2.5 in) is recommended. 4. IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical contact with the drain wire. Re-assemble the cable. Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape. - Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1). - Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire. - Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape. Page 7815 2. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 2563 to analyze the data during the time a vehicle condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a trigger point that you have determined. Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2 snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a first-in, first-out basis. If a third snapshot is taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost. Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types: Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice - Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200 frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not lost if the Scan Tool is powered down. The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis. The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected values by plotting 3 parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful, especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC. Testing for a Short to Voltage TESTING FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4. Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt, there is a short to voltage in the circuit. Testing for Continuity TESTING FOR CONTINUITY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6. Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit. 7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity. With a Test Lamp IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits. 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6. If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity. Testing for Electrical Intermittents TESTING FOR ELECTRICAL INTERMITTENTS Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment. - Testing for Short to Ground - Testing for Continuity - Testing for a Short to Voltage Page 1820 For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 4817 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) and slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. Page 2213 View of connector in released position. 4. Disconnect the connector from the component. 5. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Release the rear lower half of the wiredress cover. Page 368 View of connector in released position. 4. Disconnect the connector from the component. 5. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Release the rear lower half of the wiredress cover. Page 1477 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the rear TPA from the connector. 7. IMPORTANT: The front TPA cannot be removed from the connector. Only move it to the release point. Use a small flat-blade tool to move the front TPA to the release position. 8. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 9. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Molex Connectors Page 7996 View of connector in released position. 4. Disconnect the connector from the component. 5. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Release the rear lower half of the wiredress cover. Page 5845 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. JST Connectors JST CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, remove the connector from the component. Page 7142 Page 1632 2. Use a small flat-bladed tool to release the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting the tool in the small recess on the side of the connector and pushing up until the TPA releases from the connector body. The TPA should raise just slightly. Do not try to remove the TPA. IMPORTANT: The TPA on this connector cannot be removed unless the terminals are removed first. The TPA will come out of the connector body, but only slightly. When the TPA is slightly raised the terminals can be removed. Using excessive force to remove the TPA with the terminals still in the connector will damage the connector. 3. Repeat the process for the other side of the connector. 4. Ensure that the TPA is in the proper position to remove the terminals. Page 4212 For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 8950 5. Once the nose piece retainers are relaxed, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should raise slightly. 6. On the opposite side of the nose piece, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should release completely. If the nose piece does not come off, repeat the procedure on the opposite side. Page 884 2. Use a small flat-bladed tool to release the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting the tool in the small recess on the side of the connector and pushing up until the TPA releases from the connector body. The TPA should raise just slightly. Do not try to remove the TPA. IMPORTANT: The TPA on this connector cannot be removed unless the terminals are removed first. The TPA will come out of the connector body, but only slightly. When the TPA is slightly raised the terminals can be removed. Using excessive force to remove the TPA with the terminals still in the connector will damage the connector. 3. Repeat the process for the other side of the connector. 4. Ensure that the TPA is in the proper position to remove the terminals. Page 2307 Utility/Van Zoning UTILITY/VAN ZONING Page 155 - HVAC Actuator - Inflatable Restraint Sensing and Diagnostic Module (SDM) - Any AIR BAG module - Seatbelt Lap Anchor Pretensioner - Seatbelt Retractor Pretensioner - An SIR system connection or connector condition resulting in the following DTCs being set: B0015, B0016, B0019, B0020, B0022, or B0023 - Powertrain Control Module (PCM) - Remote Control Door Lock Receiver (RCDLR) - Transmission Control Module (TCM) Correction Important DO NOT replace the control module, wiring or component for the following conditions: - The condition is intermittent and cannot be duplicated. - The condition is present and by disconnecting and reconnecting the connector the condition can no longer be duplicated. Use the following procedure to correct the conditions listed above. 1. Install a scan tool and perform the Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle. Retrieve and record any existing history or current DTCs from all of the control modules (refer to SI). ‹› If any DTC(s) are set, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle to identify the connector(s) of the control module/component which may be causing the condition (refer to SI). ‹› If DTCs are not set, refer to Symptoms - Vehicle to identify the connector(s) of the control module/component which may be causing the condition (refer to SI). 2. When identified, use the appropriate DTC Diagnostics, Symptoms, Schematics, Component Connector End Views and Component Locator documents to locate and disconnect the affected harness connector(s) which are causing the condition. Note Fretting corrosion looks like little dark smudges on electrical terminals and appear where the actual electrical contact is being made. In less severe cases it may be unable to be seen or identified without the use of a magnifying glass. Important DO NOT apply an excessive amount of dielectric lubricant to the connectors as shown, as hydrolock may result when attempting to mate the connectors. Use ONLY a clean nylon brush that is dedicated to the repair of the conditions in this bulletin. 3. With a one-inch nylon bristle brush, apply dielectric lubricant to both the module/component side and the harness side of the affected connector(s). 4. Reconnect the affected connector(s) and wipe away any excess lubricant that may be present. 5. Attempt to duplicate the condition by using the following information: - DTC Diagnostic Procedure - Circuit/System Description - Conditions for Running the DTC - Conditions for Setting the DTC - Diagnostic Aids - Circuit/System Verification ‹› If the condition cannot be duplicated, the repair is complete. ‹› If the condition can be duplicated, then follow the appropriate DTC, Symptom or Circuit/System Testing procedure (refer to SI). Repair Order Documentation Page 4651 6. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by pressing on the tang. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (SENSOR) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) tool into the cavity on the lower right hand face of the connector until the terminal release tang access panel slides over. Page 1730 Depress the locks that are located on both sides of the wiredress cover and pull the lever over and past the locks. View of the connector when released from the component. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the front of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool push down on one of the locking tabs and pull the cover up until the dress cover releases. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. Page 6942 2. Use a small flat-bladed tool to release the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting the tool in the small recess on the side of the connector and pushing up until the TPA releases from the connector body. The TPA should raise just slightly. Do not try to remove the TPA. IMPORTANT: The TPA on this connector cannot be removed unless the terminals are removed first. The TPA will come out of the connector body, but only slightly. When the TPA is slightly raised the terminals can be removed. Using excessive force to remove the TPA with the terminals still in the connector will damage the connector. 3. Repeat the process for the other side of the connector. 4. Ensure that the TPA is in the proper position to remove the terminals. Page 523 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 420 2. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 728 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully raise the TPA on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA cannot be removed from the connector while there are terminals present in the connector body. View of the TPA when removed from the connector body. 4. Use the J 38125-12A tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the left side of the terminal release cavity as shown in the graphic. Use the tool to move the terminal release to the right with a gentle prying motion. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 6960 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link). - The wire insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. 5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold them between thumb and forefinger. 7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place. - Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction. - Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip. 8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool closes.Ensure that no strands of wire are cut. 10. Crimp the splice on each end (2). Page 3780 2. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 8508 Knock Sensor: Diagnostic Aids Arrows and Symbols Arrows and Symbols This Service Data uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations. Arrows and Symbols 1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow Basic Knowledge Required GENERAL ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures contained in the service manual. You should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current (amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram, as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. Decimal and Metric Equivalents Decimal and Metric Equivalents Page 2452 - Yazaki has a wedge or arrow shape, similar to that shown. Delphi Connectors (Micro .64) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro 64 connectors. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. The lever lock may be located on the top or sides of the wire dress cover. Page 1346 7. Apply pressure and gently rock the cover until one locking leg is unseated. 8. Continue to apply pressure and rock the cover until the second locking leg is unseated. Repeat procedure for the other side of the dress cover and remove the cover. 9. Use J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) to gently lift the terminal retaining tab while gently pulling the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 10. If the terminal is severely bent or damaged, it may be possible on some connectors to push the wire out of the front of the connector instead of Page 6587 7. Pressing the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool in the release cavity of the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and crimper in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (DOOR MODULE) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Side view of connector. View of top of connector. 1. Locate the assist lever and lock on the top of the connector. Page 441 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the DuraSeal splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of a connector. CPAs are used in all SIR System connectors and also in some connectors of other systems. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals of a connection. TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE CLIPS IMPORTANT: When making a splice in an area that may be exposed to moisture use a crimp and seal splice sleeve instead of a Splice Clip. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. Page 871 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry one side of the nose piece up to the pre-stage position. When the nose piece is in the pre-staged position, the nose piece will be raised above the connector body the length of the step in the nose piece. 7. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry the other side of the piece to the pre-stage position. If the nose piece is higher than the first step in the nose piece, gently push down on the nose piece until it meets with resistance from the connector body, you should feel the nose piece click into position. Page 5103 2. Connect the MDI to the Data Link Connector (DLC) of the vehicle. Note Use the USB port to make the following MDI connection: 3. Connect the MDI to a PC or laptop that has been downloaded with the GDS application from TIS2WEB. Note At least one Diagnostic Package must be installed on the PC to perform diagnostics. If GDS was just installed, select: Add New Diagnostic Package and then select: a Diagnostic Package to download. 4. Click: On the GDS icon on the PC. 5. The Login Page will appear. 6. Select: A User. 7. The ID Screen will appear. 8. Select: The serial number of the MDI being used. 9. Select: Connect. 10. Verify that the system status is ready by observing for a flashing PC light icon on the MDI. 11. Select: Make, Model and Model Year, in order to build the vehicle. 12. Click: Upload VIN, to allow the VIN to be reported to the PC. 13. At: The Verification step, turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. 14. Select: Next Action. 15. The Home Page will appear. 16. Select: Next. 17. The Diagnostic Screen will appear. Note Due to vehicle build, software and RPO variations, GDS may ask for additional information in Step 18. 18. Select: Engine ID, if prompted. 19. Select: Module Diagnostics. 20. Select: ECM. 21. Select: ID Information. 22. The Diagnostics page will appear. Typical View of GDS Calibration History Screen Note GDS is capable of displaying up to 10 Calibration History events. 23. Select: Calibration History from the drop down menu in order to display the following items on the screen: - Calibration History Buffer - Number of Calibration History Events Stored - Calibration Part Number History - Calibration Verification Number History 24. Select: Screenshot. 25. Name and save the file in an appropriate folder. 26. Select : Print, and retain a copy of the screenshot with the repair order. Page 8410 7. Apply pressure and gently rock the cover until one locking leg is unseated. 8. Continue to apply pressure and rock the cover until the second locking leg is unseated. Repeat procedure for the other side of the dress cover and remove the cover. 9. Use J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) to gently lift the terminal retaining tab while gently pulling the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 10. If the terminal is severely bent or damaged, it may be possible on some connectors to push the wire out of the front of the connector instead of Page 6441 Depress the locks that are located on both sides of the wiredress cover and pull the lever over and past the locks. View of the connector when released from the component. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the front of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool push down on one of the locking tabs and pull the cover up until the dress cover releases. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. Page 2343 4. Once the front 2 locks are unlocked, lift the front of the dress cover and pull it forward. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the small slot on the TPA and pushing down until the TPA releases. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to angle or rock the J 38125-21 tool when inserting it into the connector or the tool may break. Insert the J 38125-21 (GM P/N 15381651-2) tool into the round canal between the terminals cavities at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to repair Micro 64 connector terminals. The Micro 64 connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-64 (M jaw) was developed to crimp Micro 64 terminals. The J 38125-64 crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. The J 38125-64 crimping tool is also designed to crimp both the wire and the insulation at the same time. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro 64 terminals. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. 1. Cut the wire as close to the damaged terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. Page 3240 If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200 DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J 39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected. IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J 39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and maximum (MAX) values measured. 1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of a suspected circuit to the other. 2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J 39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep). IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value in order to record the full change. 5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling the connections or the wiring, test driving, or performing other operations. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions. 6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9. Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist. Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections TESTING FOR INTERMITTENT CONDITIONS AND POOR CONNECTIONS TOOLS REQUIRED - J 35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit - J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit When the condition is not currently present, but is indicated in DTC history, the cause may be intermittent. An intermittent may also be the cause when there is a customer complaint, but the symptom cannot be duplicated. Refer to the Symptom Table of the system that is suspect of causing the condition before trying to locate an intermittent condition. Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the following items: Wiring broken inside the insulation - Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector - Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself, and corrosion in the wire to terminal contact area, etc. - Pierced or damaged insulation can allow moisture to enter the wiring causing corrosion. The conductor can corrode inside the insulation, with little visible evidence. Look for swollen and stiff sections of wire in the suspect circuits. - Wiring which has been pinched, cut, or its insulation rubbed through may cause an intermittent open or short as the bare area touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle. - Wiring that comes in contact with hot or exhaust components - Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required, in order to verify the customer concern. - Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. - Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis and Vehicle Data Recorder operation. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any inline connectors before replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation. Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination, usually in the underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit. Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper adapter. Always use the J 35616 when probing connectors. Other causes of terminal deformation are improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT IN BUSSED ELECTRICAL CENTERS (BEC) Page 3252 IMPORTANT: Ensure that the dress cover and connector body are both in the released position before reassembling. Failure to do so may cause damage to the connector and component. Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (0.64) BOSCH CONNECTORS (0.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While pressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock until the lever is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Pull the rubber boot that covers the wires back to expose the end of the connector dress cover. 4. Place the connector locking lever in the center of the connector. 5. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs that are on the wire end of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover and connector body and pry up. Page 5280 Page 7824 6. Gently pry the plastic terminal retainer down and carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (16-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, pull the two connector halves apart. Page 3981 Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 9. Hand start the spark plug. Tighten the spark plug to 15 N.m (11 lb ft). 10. Install the spark plug wires at the ignition coil. 11. Install the spark plug wire to the spark plug. 12. Inspect the wires for proper installation: ^ Push sideways on each boot in order to check for proper installation. ^ Reinstall any loose boot. 13. Install the valve rocker arm. Refer to Valve Rocker Arm and Push Rod Replacement. Page 7612 - A control module from another vehicle is installed. - Revised software/calibration files have been released for this vehicle. - IMPORTANT: DO NOT re-program the control module with the SAME software/calibration files that are already present in the control module. This is not an effective repair for any type of concern. Verify that the control module contains the correct software/calibration. If incorrect programming is found, reprogram the control module with the most current software/calibration. Refer to Control Module References for replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Testing for Short to Ground TESTING FOR SHORT TO GROUND NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 4. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit. With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is a short to ground in the circuit. Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2. Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). - When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. - If the DMM does not display voltage 4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is shorted. Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A DIGITAL MULTIMETER NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the powertrain control module (PCM), should only be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200 Digital Multimeter (DMM). The J 39200 instruction manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminage even though voltage is present. The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity. IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading. Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the measurement. Page 1657 Page 3348 Fuse Block: Diagnostic Aids Arrows and Symbols Arrows and Symbols This Service Data uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations. Arrows and Symbols 1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow Basic Knowledge Required GENERAL ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures contained in the service manual. You should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current (amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram, as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. Decimal and Metric Equivalents Decimal and Metric Equivalents Page 5471 9. The illustration shows a cutaway view of the connector to aid the technician in releasing the terminal retainer. 10. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Terminal Position Assurance Locks TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Tyco/Amp Connectors (CM 42-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (CM 42-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the connector body and pull the CPA out. The CPA is on the wire harness side of connector. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 3518 Tire Pressure Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Tire Monitor System - TPM Sensor Information INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 08-03-16-003 Date: May 12, 2008 Subject: Warranty Reduction - Transfer of Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensors to Replacement Wheels and Allowable TPM Sensor Replacements Models: 2000-2009 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2003-2009 HUMMER H2 2006-2009 HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7x with On-Wheel TPM Sensors TPM Sensor / Wheel Warranty Reviews During the last warranty review period it was noted that wheels being returned under the GM New Vehicle Warranty were being shipped back to General Motors with the TPM sensor still attached to the wheel. Return rates ran as high as 60% with the TPM sensors still attached. Operational TPM sensors should not be returned to GM and are to be transferred to replacement wheels if they become necessary. Important: Operational TPM Sensors that are returned under warranty to General Motors will be charged back to the dealer.Sensors have a 10 year /150,000 mile (240,000 km) battery life, and should be transferred if one or more wheels are replaced. TPM Valve Stem / Grommet (0-ring) Replacement When the TPM sensors are transferred to new wheels you should replace the component used to seal the TPM sensor stem to the wheel. On sensors with an aluminum stem and visible nut on the outside of the wheel a replacement grommet (0-ring) should be used to assure a proper seal. The sensor retaining nut (except Aveo) should be tightened to 7 N.m (62 lb in) for all vehicles except Pontiac Vibe (4.0 N.m (35.4 lb in)). Important: ^ DO NOT overtorque the retaining nut. Notice: ^ Factory installed TPM Sensors come with plastic aluminum or nickel-plated brass stem caps. These caps should not be changed. Chrome plated steel caps may cause corrosion of aluminum valve stems due to incompatibility of the metals. On current style sensors the entire rubber stem is replaceable. The service interval on the revised TPM sensor with replaceable stem is the same as for any other traditional valve stem. Replace the stem at the time of tire replacement sensor transfer or whenever air seepage is suspected at the valve stem. When replacing the valve stem tighten the screw to 1.3 N.m (11.5 lb in). For either style of TPM sensor see the service parts guide for the correct GM part numbers to order and use. Disclaimer Page 4292 Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair Fuel Pressure Gage Installation and Removal Fuel Pressure Gage Installation and Removal Tools Required CH-48027 Digital Pressure Gage Installation Procedure Caution: Refer to Gasoline/Gasoline Vapors Caution. Caution: Remove the fuel tank cap and relieve the fuel system pressure before servicing the fuel system in order to reduce the risk of personal injury. After you relieve the fuel system pressure, a small amount of fuel may be released when servicing the fuel lines, the fuel injection pump, or the connections. In order to reduce the risk of personal injury, cover the fuel system components with a shop towel before disconnection. This will catch any fuel that may leak out. Place the towel in an approved container when the disconnection is complete. 1. Relieve the fuel system pressure. Refer to Fuel Pressure Relief. 2. Connect the CH-48027-1 (1) to the CH-48027-2 (2). 3. Remove the shop towel from around the fuel rail service port, and place in an approved gasoline container. 4. Perform any tests and/or diagnostics as needed. For the proper usage of the CH-48027 , refer to the manufacture's directions. Removal Procedure Diagram Information and Instructions Knock Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions Electrical Symbols Page 1450 - JST connectors have JST in small letters on their connectors, similar to that above. The location of the logo will vary with the connector size and style. - Kostel has an "LK" with a circle around it. These connector are usually used as a transmissions connection and are currently use on some Cadillac vehicles. Page 2544 1 - Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor 2 - Knock Sensor (KS) 2 - Right 3 - Engine Harness 4 Starter 5 - Engine Page 5567 Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. FCI Connectors FCI CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 5882 If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs SIR/SRS WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS, and the wiring components, such as connectors and terminals. IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system terminals. Use either an SIR/SRS pigtail or a terminated lead from the SIR Repair Kit Tray. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves, in order to repair the SIR/SRS wiring - A special crimping tool - A heat torch - An instruction manual The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides the necessary low resistance contact integrity for these sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors SIR/SRS CONNECTOR REPAIR (PLASTIC BODY AND TERMINAL METAL PIN) The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made with a special plating. This plating provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. Use the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit for repairing SIR/SRS terminals and connectors. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the repair kit. The J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit contains: Various terminated leads for sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) terminal replacement - Various connector positive assurance (CPA) locks for SIR/SRS connectors - Base of steering column pigtail connectors part number 12085514 - Yellow vinyl electrical tape Pigtail repair packs are available for SIR/SRS connectors with eight or less terminals. Only the connector body is available for connectors with more than eight terminals. The terminated leads in the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit can be used to replace damaged terminals when replacing the connector body. SIR/SRS COMPONENT WIRE PIGTAIL REPAIR IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails. A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device, not by a connector. If a wiring pigtail is damaged, you must replace the entire component, with pigtail. The inflatable restraint steering wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component. SIR/SRS WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 6280 Page 5963 - JST connectors have JST in small letters on their connectors, similar to that above. The location of the logo will vary with the connector size and style. - Kostel has an "LK" with a circle around it. These connector are usually used as a transmissions connection and are currently use on some Cadillac vehicles. Page 8152 Depress the locks that are located on both sides of the wiredress cover and pull the lever over and past the locks. View of the connector when released from the component. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the front of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool push down on one of the locking tabs and pull the cover up until the dress cover releases. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. Page 6975 Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Mass Airflow Sensor/Intake Air Temperature Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure Important: Use care when handling the mass air flow (MAF)/intake air temperature (IAT) sensor. Do not dent, puncture, or otherwise damage the honeycell located at the air inlet end of the MAF/IAT. Do not touch the sensing elements or allow anything including cleaning solvents and lubricants to come in contact with them. Use a small amount of a non-silicone based lubricant, on the air duct only, to aid in installation. 1. Disconnect the MAF/IAT sensor electrical connector. 2. Loosen the clamps at the MAF/IAT sensor and the throttle body. 3. Remove the air cleaner outlet duct bolt. 4. Remove the air cleaner outlet duct. 5. Loosen the clamp attaching the MAF/IAT sensor to the air cleaner housing. 6. Remove the MAF/IAT sensor from the air cleaner housing. Installation Procedure Important: The embossed arrow on the MAF/IAT sensor indicates the proper air flow direction. The arrow must point toward the engine. Page 5823 - In some cases Delphi will actually be printed on the connector. If Delphi is not printed on the connector, look for PED. In both cases there is no specific orientation for Delphi or PED and they can appear anywhere on the connector. - FCI connectors may have the FCI logo on their connectors. The logo is the letters FCI with an "A" above it. - JAE connector have JAE in small letters on their connectors. Page 5202 4. Slide the dress cover forward and off of the connector. 5. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front and rear of the connector. Page 1733 The first connector design of the Micro-Pack 100W (1) has a white connector interface that holds the terminals. The second design of the Micro-Pack 100W (2) has a gray interface to hold the terminals. Also, the first design has terminal cavities that are further apart (3 mm centerline) and offset from the other row of terminal cavities in the connector. The second design has terminals cavities that are closer together (2.54 mm centerline) and aligned vertically. One other way to identify the second design is the thin strip of material that runs along the outside of the cavities. IMPORTANT: There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W terminals which are very similar. Ensure that you have the correct terminal before crimping the new terminal to the wire. The first design connector uses the longer terminal (1) that has a raised area in front of the recess in the terminal. The second design connector uses the shorter terminal without the raised area. Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro-Pack 100W connectors. Some Micro-Pack 100W connector disassembly procedures will vary. Use this procedure as a guide. 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 4543 2. Use a small flat-bladed tool to release the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting the tool in the small recess on the side of the connector and pushing up until the TPA releases from the connector body. The TPA should raise just slightly. Do not try to remove the TPA. IMPORTANT: The TPA on this connector cannot be removed unless the terminals are removed first. The TPA will come out of the connector body, but only slightly. When the TPA is slightly raised the terminals can be removed. Using excessive force to remove the TPA with the terminals still in the connector will damage the connector. 3. Repeat the process for the other side of the connector. 4. Ensure that the TPA is in the proper position to remove the terminals. Page 2349 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Ensure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the Terminal Removal Procedure. Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PULL TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL If the terminal is visibly damaged or is suspected of having a faulty connection, the terminal should be replaced. Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors: 1. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) device and/or the secondary lock. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component or separate the connectors for in-line connectors. 3. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device. 4. Insert the proper pick or removal tool into the front of the connector body. 5. IMPORTANT: On connectors with more than one terminal the service loop may not be large enough to remove the terminal and crimp on a new one. If the terminal wire does not have a large enough service loop for removal, cut the wire 5 cm (2 in) behind the connector before removal. Grasp the wire at the back of the connector body and gently push the terminal out the front of the connector body. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. If the wire needed to be cut in order to remove the terminal, gently push a small length of the same size wire through the back of the connector cavity until there is enough wire exposed in order to crimp on a new terminal. If the wire was not cut, cut the existing wire as close to the old terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 4. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. TERMINAL INSTALLATION 1. Align the terminal and pull the wire from the back of the connector in order to seat the terminal. 2. If necessary, cut the new wire to proper length and splice with existing circuit. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. 3. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply dielectric grease to the connector. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PUSH TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 678 Page 8265 View of the connector when released from the component. View of another type of Micro 64 connector. Page 8615 Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Service and Repair Manifold Absolute Pressure Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Disconnect the manifold absolute pressure (MAP) sensor electrical connector (3). 2. Remove the MAP sensor retaining clip (2) from the intake manifold. 3. Remove the MAP sensor (1) from the intake manifold. Installation Procedure Important: Lightly coat the MAP sensor seal with clean engine oil before installing the sensor. Page 8892 vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide variety of actions, including: - Wiggling the harness - Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting - Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector - Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation - Relocating a harness or wires All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. Another option is, with the component commanded ON and OFF by the scan tool, move related connectors and wiring and observe the component operation. With the engine running, move related connectors and wiring while monitoring engine operation. If harness or connector movement affects the data displayed, component/system operation, or engine operation, inspect and repair the harness/connections as necessary. You may need to load the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these cases you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide good results as well. There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions, along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the circuit to these kinds of conditions. SALT WATER SPRAY Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture. Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5 percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously. HIGH TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070. Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault condition. The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis. This option does not allow for the same control, however. LOW TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect. If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to -18°C (0°F) from one end and +71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized cooling needs. Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or components in an effort to duplicate the concern. DUPLICATING FAILURE CONDITIONS - If none of the previous tests are successful, attempt to duplicate and/or capture the failure conditions. Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, where applicable, contains the conditions that were present when the DTC set. 1. Review and record Freeze Frame/Failure Records data. 2. Clear the DTCs using the scan tool. 3. Turn the key to OFF and wait 15 seconds. 4. Operate the vehicle under the same conditions that were noted in Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, as closely as possible. The vehicle must also be operating within the Conditions for Running the DTC. Refer to Conditions for Running the DTC in the supporting text if a DTC is being diagnosed. 5. Monitor DTC Status for the DTC being tested. The scan tool will indicate Ran, when the enabling conditions have been satisfied long enough for the DTC to run. The scan tool will also indicate whether the DTC passed or failed. - An alternate method is to drive the vehicle with the DMM connected to a suspected circuit. An abnormal reading on the DMM when the concern occurs, may help you locate the concern. Measuring Frequency Page 5350 7. Pressing the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool in the release cavity of the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and crimper in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (DOOR MODULE) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Side view of connector. View of top of connector. 1. Locate the assist lever and lock on the top of the connector. Page 8376 vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide variety of actions, including: - Wiggling the harness - Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting - Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector - Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation - Relocating a harness or wires All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. Another option is, with the component commanded ON and OFF by the scan tool, move related connectors and wiring and observe the component operation. With the engine running, move related connectors and wiring while monitoring engine operation. If harness or connector movement affects the data displayed, component/system operation, or engine operation, inspect and repair the harness/connections as necessary. You may need to load the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these cases you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide good results as well. There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions, along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the circuit to these kinds of conditions. SALT WATER SPRAY Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture. Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5 percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously. HIGH TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070. Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault condition. The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis. This option does not allow for the same control, however. LOW TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect. If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to -18°C (0°F) from one end and +71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized cooling needs. Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or components in an effort to duplicate the concern. DUPLICATING FAILURE CONDITIONS - If none of the previous tests are successful, attempt to duplicate and/or capture the failure conditions. Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, where applicable, contains the conditions that were present when the DTC set. 1. Review and record Freeze Frame/Failure Records data. 2. Clear the DTCs using the scan tool. 3. Turn the key to OFF and wait 15 seconds. 4. Operate the vehicle under the same conditions that were noted in Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, as closely as possible. The vehicle must also be operating within the Conditions for Running the DTC. Refer to Conditions for Running the DTC in the supporting text if a DTC is being diagnosed. 5. Monitor DTC Status for the DTC being tested. The scan tool will indicate Ran, when the enabling conditions have been satisfied long enough for the DTC to run. The scan tool will also indicate whether the DTC passed or failed. - An alternate method is to drive the vehicle with the DMM connected to a suspected circuit. An abnormal reading on the DMM when the concern occurs, may help you locate the concern. Measuring Frequency Page 7214 2. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 6875 vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide variety of actions, including: - Wiggling the harness - Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting - Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector - Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation - Relocating a harness or wires All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. Another option is, with the component commanded ON and OFF by the scan tool, move related connectors and wiring and observe the component operation. With the engine running, move related connectors and wiring while monitoring engine operation. If harness or connector movement affects the data displayed, component/system operation, or engine operation, inspect and repair the harness/connections as necessary. You may need to load the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these cases you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide good results as well. There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions, along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the circuit to these kinds of conditions. SALT WATER SPRAY Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture. Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5 percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously. HIGH TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070. Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault condition. The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis. This option does not allow for the same control, however. LOW TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect. If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to -18°C (0°F) from one end and +71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized cooling needs. Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or components in an effort to duplicate the concern. DUPLICATING FAILURE CONDITIONS - If none of the previous tests are successful, attempt to duplicate and/or capture the failure conditions. Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, where applicable, contains the conditions that were present when the DTC set. 1. Review and record Freeze Frame/Failure Records data. 2. Clear the DTCs using the scan tool. 3. Turn the key to OFF and wait 15 seconds. 4. Operate the vehicle under the same conditions that were noted in Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, as closely as possible. The vehicle must also be operating within the Conditions for Running the DTC. Refer to Conditions for Running the DTC in the supporting text if a DTC is being diagnosed. 5. Monitor DTC Status for the DTC being tested. The scan tool will indicate Ran, when the enabling conditions have been satisfied long enough for the DTC to run. The scan tool will also indicate whether the DTC passed or failed. - An alternate method is to drive the vehicle with the DMM connected to a suspected circuit. An abnormal reading on the DMM when the concern occurs, may help you locate the concern. Measuring Frequency Page 6416 to analyze the data during the time a vehicle condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a trigger point that you have determined. Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2 snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a first-in, first-out basis. If a third snapshot is taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost. Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types: Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice - Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200 frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not lost if the Scan Tool is powered down. The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis. The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected values by plotting 3 parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful, especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC. Testing for a Short to Voltage TESTING FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4. Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt, there is a short to voltage in the circuit. Testing for Continuity TESTING FOR CONTINUITY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6. Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit. 7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity. With a Test Lamp IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits. 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6. If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity. Testing for Electrical Intermittents TESTING FOR ELECTRICAL INTERMITTENTS Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment. - Testing for Short to Ground - Testing for Continuity - Testing for a Short to Voltage Page 4397 4. Once the front 2 locks are unlocked, lift the front of the dress cover and pull it forward. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the small slot on the TPA and pushing down until the TPA releases. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to angle or rock the J 38125-21 tool when inserting it into the connector or the tool may break. Insert the J 38125-21 (GM P/N 15381651-2) tool into the round canal between the terminals cavities at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to repair Micro 64 connector terminals. The Micro 64 connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-64 (M jaw) was developed to crimp Micro 64 terminals. The J 38125-64 crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. The J 38125-64 crimping tool is also designed to crimp both the wire and the insulation at the same time. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro 64 terminals. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. 1. Cut the wire as close to the damaged terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. Page 8869 Page 5539 difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Bosch Connectors (ECM) BOSCH CONNECTORS (ECM) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the assist lever on the top of the connector. Move the assist lever to the forward position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Specifications Crankshaft Gear/Sprocket: Specifications Crankshaft Sprocket Install the crankshaft sprocket (207) onto the front of the crankshaft. Align the crankshaft key with the crankshaft sprocket keyway. Use the J 41478 (1) and the J 41665 (2) in order to install the crankshaft sprocket. Install the sprocket onto the crankshaft until fully seated against the crankshaft flange. Rotate the crankshaft sprocket until the alignment mark is in the 12 o'clock position. Page 2051 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link). - The wire insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. 5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold them between thumb and forefinger. 7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place. - Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction. - Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip. 8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool closes.Ensure that no strands of wire are cut. 10. Crimp the splice on each end (2). Page 856 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) and slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. Page 8177 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry one side of the nose piece up to the pre-stage position. When the nose piece is in the pre-staged position, the nose piece will be raised above the connector body the length of the step in the nose piece. 7. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry the other side of the piece to the pre-stage position. If the nose piece is higher than the first step in the nose piece, gently push down on the nose piece until it meets with resistance from the connector body, you should feel the nose piece click into position. Page 187 Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. For connectors with a bolt in the dress cover, turn the bolt counterclockwise to remove the connector from the component. 2. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. A/T - Key Will Not Release From Ignition Lock Cylinder Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Key Will Not Release From Ignition Lock Cylinder Bulletin No.: 05-07-30-021B Date: October 04, 2007 TECHNICAL Subject: Ignition Key Will Not Remove From Ignition Lock Cylinder (Reposition Shifter Boot) Models: 2004-2007 Buick Rainier 2002-2008 Chevrolet TrailBlazer Models 2002-2008 GMC Envoy Models 2003-2004 Oldsmobile Bravada Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to include the 2008 model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 05-07-30-021A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle). Condition Some customers may comment that they are unable to remove the ignition key from the ignition cylinder. Cause The shifter boot may be caught/trapped in the shifter assembly mechanism. Correction Inspect the shifter boot for being caught/trapped in the shifter assembly. If the shifter boot is NOT caught/trapped in the shift assembly, refer to Ignition Key Cannot Be Removed from the Ignition Lock Cylinder in SI. If the shifter boot IS caught/trapped in the shifter assembly, continue with the next step. DO NOT replace the complete shifter assembly for this condition. ONLY replace the shifter boot/handle if damaged by shifter assembly. Reposition the shifter boot so that it is not caught/trapped in the shifter assembly. Warranty Information Page 494 View of a typical Micro 64 connector. Depress the lock and pull the lever over and past the lock. Page 4283 Disclaimer Page 3045 10. Remove the bracket from the stud. 11. Turn the compressor hose assembly to clear the heat shield. 12. Lift and remove the compressor hose assembly from the compressor. 13. Remove the compressor hose assembly from the condenser. 14. Remove the compressor hose assembly. 15. Remove the compressor hose from the A/C compressor. 16. Remove the compressor hose from the condenser. 17. Disconnect the electrical connector from the A/C low pressure switch. 18. Remove the nut from the compressor hose at the accumulator. 19. Remove the compressor hose from the accumulator. 20. Remove the compressor hose from the vehicle. 21. Discard all of the used sealing washers. Cap the system openings. Installation Procedure 1. Install the compressor hose assembly. 2. Install the compressor hose to the condenser using new sealing washers. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 3. Install the compressor hose nut to the condenser. Tighten the nut to 16 N.m (12 lb ft). 4. Connect the electrical connector to the A/C low pressure switch. Page 7499 - Yazaki has a wedge or arrow shape, similar to that shown. Delphi Connectors (Micro .64) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro 64 connectors. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. The lever lock may be located on the top or sides of the wire dress cover. Page 5460 View of typical connector. View of connector in released position. 1. Locate the assist lever at the back of the connector. Move the assist lever to the rear position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the dress cover. Body Control Module (BCM) C1 Body Control Module (BCM) C1 Page 7166 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. 4. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front of the connector. Page 7061 View of typical connector. View of connector in released position. 1. Locate the assist lever at the back of the connector. Move the assist lever to the rear position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the dress cover. Page 2285 If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the DuraSeal splice sleeves. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: - Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. - Do not use the crimp and DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 to crimp DuraSeal splice sleeve. In order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 1468 Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. FCI Connectors FCI CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 7427 Engine Control Module (ECM) C3 (Pin 1 To 15) Page 4509 2. Locate the nose piece locking tabs that are positioned on the side of the connector nose piece. The connector nose piece acts as a terminal positive assurance (TPA) and may be referred to as such. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to push in one of the locking tabs while gently pulling on the same side of the nose piece. 4. Repeat the procedure for the other locking tab and remove the nose piece. 5. Remove the wire dress cover. The following is a general procedure for wire dress cover removal. Use this procedure as a guide, some dress cover removal procedures may vary. 6. Use fingers to squeeze the 2 locking legs of the cover. Page 8373 Page 3987 2. Remove the serpentine belt from the accessory drive system. 3. Install the tool onto the power steering pulley. Position the legs of the tool into the outer grooves of the pulley, farthest from the front of the engine. 4. Install the retaining cord around the pulley and to the legs of the tool. 5. Put on the laser safety glasses provided with the tool. 6. Depress the switch on the rear of the tool to activate the light beam. 7. Rotate the power steering pulley as required to project the light beam onto the crankshaft balancer pulley grooves. 8. Inspect for proper power steering pulley alignment. - If the laser beam projects onto the second rib or raised area (1), the pulleys are aligned properly. - If the laser beam projects more than one-quarter rib 0.9 mm (0.035 in) mis-alignment, adjust the position of the power steering pulley as required. - Refer to SI for Power Steering Pulley Removal and Installation procedures. 9. Install the serpentine belt to the accessory drive system in the original orientation. 10. Operate the vehicle and verify that the belt noise concern is no longer present. Tool Information Please visit the GM service tool website for pricing information or to place your order for this tool. Page 6037 Oxygen Sensor: Service Precautions Silicon Contamination of Heated Oxygen Sensors Notice Silicon Contamination of Heated Oxygen Sensors Notice Notice: Contamination of the oxygen sensor can result from the use of an inappropriate RTV sealant (not oxygen sensor safe) or excessive engine coolant or oil consumption. Remove the HO2S and visually inspect the portion of the sensor exposed to the exhaust stream in order to check for contamination. If contaminated, the portion of the sensor exposed to the exhaust stream will have a white powdery coating. Silicon contamination causes a high but false HO2S signal voltage (rich exhaust indication). The control module will then reduce the amount of fuel delivered to the engine, causing a severe driveability problem. Eliminate the source of contamination before replacing the oxygen sensor. Page 7159 Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested: - Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. - Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a component or to other harnesses. - If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A TEST LAMP TOOLS REQUIRED J 35616-200 Test Light - Probe Kit NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminate even though voltage is present. The J 35616-200 is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair of leads. To properly operate this tool use the following procedures. When testing for voltage: 1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested. When testing for ground: 1. Attach one lead to battery positive voltage. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where ground should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is ground at the point being tested. Using Connector Test Adapters USING CONNECTOR TEST ADAPTERS NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Using Fused Jumper Wires USING FUSED JUMPER WIRES TOOLS REQUIRED J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged. The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested. AFL/ECP Connectors AFL/EPC CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 3310 breakers are used. CIRCUIT BREAKER This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high current is removed. POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) CIRCUIT BREAKER This type greatly increases its resistance when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker will re-close within a second or 2. Circuit Protection - Fuses CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSES The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and examine the element in the fuse for an open (2). If not broken (1), also check for continuity using a DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one of equal current rating. Circuit Protection - Fusible Links CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSIBLE LINKS Page 438 11. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 12. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 13. Center the high temperature SCT1 shrink tube over the DuraSeal splice sleeve. 14. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the high temperature heat shrink tubing. 15. Gradually move the heat from the center to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 16. Replace any reflective tape and clips that may have been remove during the repair. Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation REPAIRING DAMAGED WIRE INSULATION Wire Size Conversion Page 8672 Connector Anatomy Connector Repairs contains a list of all connector repairs. The connector repairs are listed by the connector manufacturer and then by connector type. If the technician cannot identify the manufacturer of the connector, refer to Identifying Connectors below. Knowing the connector manufacturer will assist in finding the correct connector repair from the following list: - Connector Position Assurance Locks - Terminal Position Assurance Locks - Bosch Connectors (0.64) Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) Bosch Connectors (BSK) Bosch Connectors (ECM) - Delphi Connectors (Micro.64) Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) Delphi Connectors (12-Way) - Tyco/AMP Connectors (CM 42-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) Tyco/AMP Connectors (025 Cap) Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) - Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) - Repairing Connector Terminals IDENTIFYING CONNECTORS Knowing the connector manufacturer is helpful when trying to locating the correct connector repair procedure. There are many different connector designs used on GM vehicles and it is sometimes difficult to identify the connector manufacturer. The information in this document should help with the identification of connector manufactures. The following connector manufacturers make most of the connectors found in GM vehicles: AFL/EPC (Alcoa Fujikura Ltd./Engineered Plastics Components) - Bosch - Delphi - FCI (Framatome Connectors International) - JAE (Japan Aviation Electronics) - JST (Japan Solderless Terminals) Page 7694 5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape. Seat Belt Schematic Icons Seat Belt Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons Page 1782 11. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 12. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 13. Center the high temperature SCT1 shrink tube over the DuraSeal splice sleeve. 14. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the high temperature heat shrink tubing. 15. Gradually move the heat from the center to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 16. Replace any reflective tape and clips that may have been remove during the repair. Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation REPAIRING DAMAGED WIRE INSULATION Wire Size Conversion Page 2615 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 5222 View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. View of the release tool being used for the smaller terminals. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (2-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 6105 Release the lower wiredress cover locking tab. Release the upper wiredress cover locking tab. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. Page 5467 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 7406 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Start in the middle and gradually move the heat barrel to the open ends of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Heated Oxygen Sensor Wiring Repairs HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being obstructed. If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. - Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks, etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire. - Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance. - To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector. Page 3705 Page 8434 5. Once the nose piece retainers are relaxed, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should raise slightly. 6. On the opposite side of the nose piece, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should release completely. If the nose piece does not come off, repeat the procedure on the opposite side. Page 4446 The engine harness may be repaired using the J-38125. High Temperature Wiring Repairs HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperatures, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time may use materials i.e. wires, connectors, and shielding that has a higher heat rating than typical wiring. When making a repair in a high temperature area observe the following: Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature to replace any damaged wire. - Replace any heat shielding that is removed. - Cover any DuraSeal splice sleeves with SCT1 shrink tubing (available in the J-38125 Terminal Repair kit). - After making a wiring repair, ensure that the location of the wiring is not moved closer to the heat source. IDENTIFYING HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperature, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time need special considerations when making wiring repairs. Areas that may be exposed to higher temperatures can be identified by heat resistant materials that are being used in those areas. These materials may include heat reflective tape, moon tape, and high temperature shrink tubing. Also conduit and other protective coverings may be used. Because conduit or similar coverings are used throughout the vehicle regardless of the temperature, it may be necessary for the technician to determine if an area is exposed to excessive heat before making a wiring repair. Obvious areas of consideration would be any area located near the exhaust manifolds, catalytic converter, and exhaust pipes. The J-38125 contains much of the material you will need to perform repairs on areas exposed to high heat. The kit contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves to crimp and seal connections - High temperature SCT1 shrink tubing to protect the splice sleeves - A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct crimp tool to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools to remove the terminals from the connectors The J-38125 does not contain wire that is suitable to high temperature exposure. Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature of the same or larger gage size as the original wire when repair damage wire. Also replace any reflective tape that you remove during the repair. HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature rating of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125 and then encapsulate the splice sleeve using the high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the order listed. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip keeping all of the wire strands intact. Page 6536 View of connector in released position. 4. Disconnect the connector from the component. 5. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Release the rear lower half of the wiredress cover. Page 8199 Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size. REPAIRING A FUSIBLE LINK IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient overload protection. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. Flat Wire Repairs FLAT WIRE REPAIRS NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced. GMLAN Wiring Repairs GMLAN WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The GM Local Area Network (GMLAN) System requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working on GMLAN connectors and terminals. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items in order to repair the GMLAN wiring: Dura Seal splice sleeves - A wire stripping tool - J 38125-8 Crimping Tool (GM P/N 12085115) - J 38125-5 Ultra Torch Special Tool (GM P/N 12085116) The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. - A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors GMLAN REPAIRS IMPORTANT: When making a repair to any GMLAN network, the original wire length after the repair must be the same length as before the repair. If the network is a twisted pair, the twist must be maintained after the repair is completed. GMLAN has 2 types of networks, low speed and high speed. Low speed GMLAN has a single wire and works at slow speeds. High speed GMLAN has 2 wires in a twisted pair and works at higher speeds. For more information on GMLAN, refer to Data Link Communications Description and Operation. GMLAN CONNECTOR TERMINAL REPAIR IMPORTANT: A service terminal can be used to replace damaged connector terminals for both high speed and low speed GMLAN systems. When making a connector terminal repair on a GMLAN high speed system with twisted pair wires, do not untwist the wires more than necessary to make the repair. The terminals in the GMLAN system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are available in the J-38125. If the individual terminals are damaged on any GMLAN connection, use the appropriate connector repair procedure in order to repair the terminal. GMLAN WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 7540 2. Use a small flat-bladed tool to release the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting the tool in the small recess on the side of the connector and pushing up until the TPA releases from the connector body. The TPA should raise just slightly. Do not try to remove the TPA. IMPORTANT: The TPA on this connector cannot be removed unless the terminals are removed first. The TPA will come out of the connector body, but only slightly. When the TPA is slightly raised the terminals can be removed. Using excessive force to remove the TPA with the terminals still in the connector will damage the connector. 3. Repeat the process for the other side of the connector. 4. Ensure that the TPA is in the proper position to remove the terminals. Page 2510 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the DuraSeal splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of a connector. CPAs are used in all SIR System connectors and also in some connectors of other systems. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals of a connection. TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE CLIPS IMPORTANT: When making a splice in an area that may be exposed to moisture use a crimp and seal splice sleeve instead of a Splice Clip. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. Page 1260 steering column. 10. Depress the horn contacts in the steering wheel. Does the horn work? ^ Yes - Check if the operation of the horn is sensitive to pressure applied to the steering wheel as if a driver were doing a panic stop. In some cases, pressure applied to the steering wheel in different directions will expose a bad ground path in the steering column. Proceed to step 11. ^ No - proceed with step 11. 11. Inspect the steering column through the insulator panel location. Note: The shaft from the steering wheel comes through a metal bracket. That bracket is surrounded by plastic, which is inside of another metal bracket. Look for a small metal clip (refer to the "horn clip" graphic) that connects the inner bracket (inside the plastic) and the outer bracket. This clip provides an auxiliary ground path which is needed in some cases, if the primary path has a bad connection. 12. To verify this, connect a test light between the red wire on the horn contacts in the steering wheel and the steering column sections (1) and (2) in the illustration. Does the horn work when grounded to (1) and not (2)? ^ Yes - add or replace the horn clip. ^ No - refer to the Horn Inoperative section in SI to diagnose which component in the circuit is causing the horn inoperative condition. Parts Information Warranty Information Disclaimer Page 8996 Page 2453 View of a typical Micro 64 connector. Depress the lock and pull the lever over and past the lock. Audio - Inadvertent Steering Wheel Button Activation Remote Switch: Technical Service Bulletins Audio - Inadvertent Steering Wheel Button Activation INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 08-08-44-028 Date: August 28, 2008 Subject: Information On Inadvertent Steering Wheel Control (SWC) Button Press Causing Radio Anomalies Models: 2009 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2009 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3 Models 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X All Vehicles with Steering Wheel Controls This bulletin is being issued to provide a recommendation for vehicles with a customer concern of the radio station tuning changing by itself, volume changing by itself, radio changing by itself, or radio muting or going silent when driving and turning the steering wheel. The switches on the right hand side of the steering wheel are easily pressed and may inadvertently be pressed when turning the steering wheel. These concerns may be affected by the location of the steering wheel controls. Recommendation Do Not Replace The Radio 1. Please determine that the switch controls on the steering wheel are functioning correctly. 2. Ask the customer if their hand was in close proximity to the steering wheel controls when the condition happened. Explain to the customer that bumping the controls would have caused this undesired action. Explain to the customer the proper use and function of the steering wheel controls. Disclaimer Page 4924 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Ensure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the Terminal Removal Procedure. Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PULL TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL If the terminal is visibly damaged or is suspected of having a faulty connection, the terminal should be replaced. Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors: 1. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) device and/or the secondary lock. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component or separate the connectors for in-line connectors. 3. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device. 4. Insert the proper pick or removal tool into the front of the connector body. 5. IMPORTANT: On connectors with more than one terminal the service loop may not be large enough to remove the terminal and crimp on a new one. If the terminal wire does not have a large enough service loop for removal, cut the wire 5 cm (2 in) behind the connector before removal. Grasp the wire at the back of the connector body and gently push the terminal out the front of the connector body. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. If the wire needed to be cut in order to remove the terminal, gently push a small length of the same size wire through the back of the connector cavity until there is enough wire exposed in order to crimp on a new terminal. If the wire was not cut, cut the existing wire as close to the old terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 4. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. TERMINAL INSTALLATION 1. Align the terminal and pull the wire from the back of the connector in order to seat the terminal. 2. If necessary, cut the new wire to proper length and splice with existing circuit. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. 3. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply dielectric grease to the connector. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PUSH TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 7989 to analyze the data during the time a vehicle condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a trigger point that you have determined. Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2 snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a first-in, first-out basis. If a third snapshot is taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost. Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types: Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice - Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200 frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not lost if the Scan Tool is powered down. The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis. The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected values by plotting 3 parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful, especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC. Testing for a Short to Voltage TESTING FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4. Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt, there is a short to voltage in the circuit. Testing for Continuity TESTING FOR CONTINUITY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6. Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit. 7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity. With a Test Lamp IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits. 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6. If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity. Testing for Electrical Intermittents TESTING FOR ELECTRICAL INTERMITTENTS Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment. - Testing for Short to Ground - Testing for Continuity - Testing for a Short to Voltage Page 6745 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches, and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original. - The wires insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the possibility of fuel contact. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1). 5. Select the proper duraseal splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool. Refer to the Crimp and Seal Splice Table. 6. Place the duraseal splice sleeve in the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115) crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 7. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to hold the duraseal splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 8. Insert the wires into the duraseal splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel in order to prevent the wire from passing through the splice (3). 9. Close the handles of the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115), until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is applied to the splice sleeve. 10. Shrink the insulation around the splice. - Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. - Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Splicing Inline Harness Diodes SPLICING INLINE HARNESS DIODES Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure. 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode. 2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool. 5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode. Page 8560 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Kostal Connectors KOSTAL CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 6094 Depress the locks that are located on both sides of the wiredress cover and pull the lever over and past the locks. View of the connector when released from the component. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the front of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool push down on one of the locking tabs and pull the cover up until the dress cover releases. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. Page 5197 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. JST Connectors JST CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, remove the connector from the component. Page 4173 6. Disconnect the electrical connector (1) from the mass air flow (MAF)/intake air temperature (IAT) sensor. 7. Remove the harness clips from the fuel rail. 8. Perform the following steps in order to disconnect the fuel injector electrical connectors. 1. Mark the connectors to their corresponding injectors to ensure correct reassembly. 2. Pull the connector position assurance (CPA) retainer (2) on the connector up one click. 3. Push the tab (1) on the connector in. 4. Disconnect the fuel injector electrical connector. 5. Repeat the steps for each injector electrical connector. Page 6823 4. Install the ground, then the washer and then the bolt to the frame. Important: It is important to use the bolts, washers and nuts specified in this bulletin. These parts have been identified due to their conductive finish. 5. Install a washer and nut to the back side of the frame. Tighten Tighten the nut to 9 Nm (79 lb in). 6. Cover the front and back side of the repair area using Rubberized Undercoating. An additional check can be made to ensure a good connection for the battery cable to frame ground. It is possible for this ground to cause similar symptoms with the ABS as described above. *We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may be available from other sources. Parts Information Warranty Information Disclaimer Page 8318 11. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 12. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 13. Center the high temperature SCT1 shrink tube over the DuraSeal splice sleeve. 14. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the high temperature heat shrink tubing. 15. Gradually move the heat from the center to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 16. Replace any reflective tape and clips that may have been remove during the repair. Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation REPAIRING DAMAGED WIRE INSULATION Wire Size Conversion Page 2835 Verify Original Equipment Condition of the Vehicle - Verify that Original Equipment Tires and Wheels or Official GM Accessory Tires and Wheels are on the vehicle. - Verify that aftermarket suspension "Lift" or "Lowering" Kits or other suspension alterations have NOT been done to the vehicle. - Check for accidental damage to the vehicle; for example, severe pothole or curb impacts, collision damage that may have affected the wheel alignment of the vehicle; e.g., engine cradles, suspension control arms, axles, wheels, wheel covers, tires may show evidence of damage/impact. - Check to be sure vehicle has seen "Normal Use" rather than abuse; e.g., very aggressive driving may show up by looking at the tires and condition of the vehicle. - Check for other additional equipment items that may significantly affect vehicle mass such as large tool boxes, campers, snow plow packages (without the snowplow RPO), etc., especially in trucks and cutaway/incomplete vehicles. Significant additional mass can affect trim height and wheel alignment of the vehicle and may necessitate a customer pay wheel alignment when placed semi-permanently in the vehicle (Upfitter instructions are to realign the vehicle after placement of these types of items. (This typically applies to trucks and incomplete vehicles that can be upfit with equipment such as the above.) Customer Concerns, "Normal Operation" Conditions and "Mileage Policy" Possible Concerns The following are typical conditions that may require wheel alignment warranty service: 1. Lead/Pull: defined as "at a constant highway speed on a typical straight road, the amount of effort required at the steering wheel to maintain the vehicle's straight heading." Important Please evaluate for the condition with hands-on the steering wheel. Follow the "Vehicle Leads/Pulls" diagnostic tree located in SI to determine the cause of a lead/pull concern. Lead/Pull concerns can be due to road crown or road slope, tires, wheel alignment or even in rare circumstances a steering gear issue. Lead/pull concerns due to road crown are considered "Normal Operation" and are NOT a warrantable condition -- the customer should be advised that this is "Normal Operation." Important Some customers may comment on a "Lead/Pull" when they hold the steering wheel in a level condition. If so, this is more likely a "steering wheel angle" concern because the customer is "steering" the vehicle to obtain a "level" steering wheel. 2. Steering wheel angle to the left or right (counter-clockwise or clockwise, respectively): Defined as the steering wheel angle (clocking) deviation from "level" while maintaining a straight heading on a typical straight road. 3. Irregular or Premature tire wear: Slight to very slight "feathering" or "edge" wear on the shoulders of tires is NOT considered unusual and should even out with a tire rotation; if the customer is concerned about a "feathering" condition of the tires, the customer could be advised to rotate the tires earlier than the next scheduled mileage/maintenance interval (but no later than the next interval). Be sure to understand the customer's driving habits as this will also heavily influence the tire wear performance; tire wear from aggressive or abusive driving habits is NOT a warrantable condition. Important Slight or mild feathering, cupping, edge or heel/toe wear of tire tread shoulders is "normal" and can show up very early in a tire/vehicle service mileage; in fact, some new tires can show evidence of feathering from the factory. These issues do NOT affect the overall performance and tread life of the tire. Dealer personnel should always check the customer's maintenance records to ensure that tire inflation pressure is being maintained to placard and that the tires are being rotated (modified-X pattern) at the proper mileage intervals. Wheel alignments are NOT to be performed for the types of "Normal" Tire Feathering shown in Figures 1-4 below. Page 5795 All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system. Page 4512 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Ensure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the Terminal Removal Procedure. Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PULL TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL If the terminal is visibly damaged or is suspected of having a faulty connection, the terminal should be replaced. Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors: 1. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) device and/or the secondary lock. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component or separate the connectors for in-line connectors. 3. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device. 4. Insert the proper pick or removal tool into the front of the connector body. 5. IMPORTANT: On connectors with more than one terminal the service loop may not be large enough to remove the terminal and crimp on a new one. If the terminal wire does not have a large enough service loop for removal, cut the wire 5 cm (2 in) behind the connector before removal. Grasp the wire at the back of the connector body and gently push the terminal out the front of the connector body. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. If the wire needed to be cut in order to remove the terminal, gently push a small length of the same size wire through the back of the connector cavity until there is enough wire exposed in order to crimp on a new terminal. If the wire was not cut, cut the existing wire as close to the old terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 4. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. TERMINAL INSTALLATION 1. Align the terminal and pull the wire from the back of the connector in order to seat the terminal. 2. If necessary, cut the new wire to proper length and splice with existing circuit. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. 3. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply dielectric grease to the connector. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PUSH TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 2173 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the DuraSeal splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of a connector. CPAs are used in all SIR System connectors and also in some connectors of other systems. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals of a connection. TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE CLIPS IMPORTANT: When making a splice in an area that may be exposed to moisture use a crimp and seal splice sleeve instead of a Splice Clip. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. Page 3798 11. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 12. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 13. Center the high temperature SCT1 shrink tube over the DuraSeal splice sleeve. 14. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the high temperature heat shrink tubing. 15. Gradually move the heat from the center to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 16. Replace any reflective tape and clips that may have been remove during the repair. Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation REPAIRING DAMAGED WIRE INSULATION Wire Size Conversion Page 4803 - Most Molex connectors will have the Molex logo on the dresscover of the connector. In some cases the connectors may have MX followed by another letter. The third letter indicates where the connector was made. A connector with MXD is a Molex connector made in Detroit. Sumitomo has a unique symbol on their connector and possibly a part number. The symbol is similar to that of a diamond lying on its side, similar to that shown. The logo could appear anywhere but the most common place is at the wire side of the housing. Tyco/AMP has many different and unique connector designs. Some may or may not have identifiable marks on them. Page 1416 Page 4941 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. 4. Remove the dress cover by using a flat bladed tool to release the dress cover locking tabs and lift up on the dress cover. 5. Cut the tie wrap that holds the wires to the connector body. Page 9071 4. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the rear of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. 5. Once the locking tabs are unlocked, slide the inner connector out of the rear of the connector housing. Page 3785 5. While pushing the terminal forward, insert the J 38125-24 in the release cavity above the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (43-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Page 2635 Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size. REPAIRING A FUSIBLE LINK IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient overload protection. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. Flat Wire Repairs FLAT WIRE REPAIRS NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced. GMLAN Wiring Repairs GMLAN WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The GM Local Area Network (GMLAN) System requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working on GMLAN connectors and terminals. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items in order to repair the GMLAN wiring: Dura Seal splice sleeves - A wire stripping tool - J 38125-8 Crimping Tool (GM P/N 12085115) - J 38125-5 Ultra Torch Special Tool (GM P/N 12085116) The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. - A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors GMLAN REPAIRS IMPORTANT: When making a repair to any GMLAN network, the original wire length after the repair must be the same length as before the repair. If the network is a twisted pair, the twist must be maintained after the repair is completed. GMLAN has 2 types of networks, low speed and high speed. Low speed GMLAN has a single wire and works at slow speeds. High speed GMLAN has 2 wires in a twisted pair and works at higher speeds. For more information on GMLAN, refer to Data Link Communications Description and Operation. GMLAN CONNECTOR TERMINAL REPAIR IMPORTANT: A service terminal can be used to replace damaged connector terminals for both high speed and low speed GMLAN systems. When making a connector terminal repair on a GMLAN high speed system with twisted pair wires, do not untwist the wires more than necessary to make the repair. The terminals in the GMLAN system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are available in the J-38125. If the individual terminals are damaged on any GMLAN connection, use the appropriate connector repair procedure in order to repair the terminal. GMLAN WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 2421 All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system. Page 5631 7. Wrap electrical tape around the connection as shown. 8. Route the engine coolant heater cord and extension cord behind the alternator and adjacent to the engine coolant crossover pipe as shown. 9. Continue to route the extension cord to the exit location desired by the customer as shown. 10. Review the routing of the coolant heater cord and extension cord to verify that it does not touch any sharp edges that could damage it. 11. Secure the engine coolant heater cord and the extension cord with tie straps as needed. 12. Resecure any of the original clips that retained the engine coolant heater cord to the vehicle that were released to provide length. Part Information The extension cord may be obtained at any of the following outlets: - Lowes* - Home Depot* - Canada: Acklands-Grainger* (www.acklandsgrainger.com), Catalogue Part Number: CWRSJTOW3C14-10 USA: Cords should bear the UL symbol. Canada: Cords should bear the ULc symbol or CSA approval. *We believe these sources and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume any responsibility for the products or material from these firms or for any such items that may be available from other sources. Page 754 2. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully push the terminal position assurance (TPA) towards the face of the connector on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA is fragile and may break if not done carefully. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. 3. Use the J 38125-215 tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 2063 Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair Park/Neutral Position Switch Replacement Tools Required J 41364-A Park/Neutral Switch Aligner Removal Procedure 1. Apply the parking brake. 2. Shift the transmission into neutral. 3. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 4. Remove the nut securing the transmission control lever to the manual shaft. 5. Remove the transmission control lever from the manual shaft. 6. Disconnect the electrical connectors from the switch. 7. Remove the bolts securing the park/neutral position switch to the transmission. 8. Remove the park/neutral position switch from the manual shaft. If the park/neutral position switch did not slide off the manual shaft, file the outer edge of the manual shaft in order to remove any burrs. Installation Procedure 1. Install the switch to the transmission manual shaft by aligning the switch hub flats with the manual shaft flats. 2. Slide the switch onto the transmission manual shaft until the switch mounting bracket contacts the mounting bosses on the transmission. Important: If a new switch is being installed, the switch will come with a positive assurance bracket. The positive assurance bracket aligns the new switch in it proper position for installation and the use of neutral position adjustment tool will not be necessary. 3. Install the switch to the transmission with 2 bolts finger tight. Locations Headlamp Relay: Locations Fuse Block - Underhood (5.3L/6.0L), Label Page 8903 View of connector in released position. 4. Disconnect the connector from the component. 5. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Release the rear lower half of the wiredress cover. Page 7045 2. Locate the nose piece locking tabs that are positioned on the side of the connector nose piece. The connector nose piece acts as a terminal positive assurance (TPA) and may be referred to as such. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to push in one of the locking tabs while gently pulling on the same side of the nose piece. 4. Repeat the procedure for the other locking tab and remove the nose piece. 5. Remove the wire dress cover. The following is a general procedure for wire dress cover removal. Use this procedure as a guide, some dress cover removal procedures may vary. 6. Use fingers to squeeze the 2 locking legs of the cover. Page 5655 Page 137 Emergency Contact Module: Service and Repair OnStar Module Bracket Assembly Replacement (Trailblazer, Envoy, Rainier) OnStar Module Bracket Assembly Replacement (Trailblazer, Envoy, Rainier) Removal Procedure 1. Remove the right rear seat cushion. 2. Remove the communication interface module. 3. Using a flat bladed tool, release the retaining tab on the upper bracket. 4. Slide the upper bracket inboard until the retaining tabs are released from the processor bracket. 5. Remove the upper bracket from the processor bracket. 6. Remove the nut that retains the processor bracket to the rear seat back stud. 7. Remove the processor bracket from the vehicle. Installation Procedure 1. Install the processor bracket to the rear seat studs. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Install the nut to the rear seat back stud. Tighten the nut to 45 N.m (33 lb ft). Page 2553 Utility/Van Zoning UTILITY/VAN ZONING Page 4834 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 7497 - JST connectors have JST in small letters on their connectors, similar to that above. The location of the logo will vary with the connector size and style. - Kostel has an "LK" with a circle around it. These connector are usually used as a transmissions connection and are currently use on some Cadillac vehicles. Page 1729 View of the connector when released from the component. View of another type of Micro 64 connector. Page 8997 Page 1269 Steering Wheel And Column Page 2340 View of a typical Micro 64 connector. Depress the lock and pull the lever over and past the lock. Page 2466 Release the lower wiredress cover locking tab. Release the upper wiredress cover locking tab. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. Page 5848 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Kostal Connectors KOSTAL CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 499 The first connector design of the Micro-Pack 100W (1) has a white connector interface that holds the terminals. The second design of the Micro-Pack 100W (2) has a gray interface to hold the terminals. Also, the first design has terminal cavities that are further apart (3 mm centerline) and offset from the other row of terminal cavities in the connector. The second design has terminals cavities that are closer together (2.54 mm centerline) and aligned vertically. One other way to identify the second design is the thin strip of material that runs along the outside of the cavities. IMPORTANT: There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W terminals which are very similar. Ensure that you have the correct terminal before crimping the new terminal to the wire. The first design connector uses the longer terminal (1) that has a raised area in front of the recess in the terminal. The second design connector uses the shorter terminal without the raised area. Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro-Pack 100W connectors. Some Micro-Pack 100W connector disassembly procedures will vary. Use this procedure as a guide. 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 8995 Page 206 View of the connector when released from the component. View of another type of Micro 64 connector. Page 2058 Page 8855 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Start in the middle and gradually move the heat barrel to the open ends of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Heated Oxygen Sensor Wiring Repairs HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being obstructed. If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. - Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks, etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire. - Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance. - To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector. Page 6742 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the DuraSeal splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of a connector. CPAs are used in all SIR System connectors and also in some connectors of other systems. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals of a connection. TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE CLIPS IMPORTANT: When making a splice in an area that may be exposed to moisture use a crimp and seal splice sleeve instead of a Splice Clip. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. Page 231 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. 4. Remove the dress cover by using a flat bladed tool to release the dress cover locking tabs and lift up on the dress cover. 5. Cut the tie wrap that holds the wires to the connector body. Page 7312 Note The dealer will receive an e-mail reply after the calibrations have been validated. The e-mail reply will advise the dealer if the calibrations are OEM. 28. Allow two hours for the PQC to verify the calibrations and set up the case details. ‹› If the PQC determines that the calibrations ARE aftermarket calibrations, DO NOT contact GM Technical Assistance to discuss warranty concerns on the aftermarket calibrations. ALL questions and concerns about warranty should be directed to the dealers Fixed Operations Manager (FOM), (Warranty Manager (WM) in Canada). 29. You may call the PQC two hours after submitting the e-mail for authorization to replace the assembly. This will provide them time to receive, review and set up a case on the request. Please be prepared to provide all the usual documentation that is normally required when requesting an assembly authorization from the PQC. Warranty Information - The Dealership Service Management must be involved in any situation that would justify the use of labor operation Z1111. - Notify the Fixed Operations Manager (FOM) (Warranty Manager (WM) in Canada) of the situation. - All claims will have to be routed to the FOM (WM in Canada) for approval. - Please refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 09-00-89-016, Labor Operation Z1111 - Suspected Tampering or Vehicle Modifications for important information. For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table above. Disclaimer Page 2819 Behind The Center Of The I/P (With RPO Code Z88 & Z89) Page 697 5. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove TPA from the connector. 6. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Page 3711 Utility/Van Zoning UTILITY/VAN ZONING Page 4176 14. Disconnect the fuel feed pipe (3) from the fuel rail (2). Refer to Metal Collar Quick Connect Fitting Service. 15. Remove the vacuum brake booster hose from the rear of the intake manifold. Page 7602 Page 1981 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. 4. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front of the connector. Page 2163 View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. 4. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers CIRCUIT PROTECTION - CIRCUIT BREAKERS A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types of circuit Page 7828 Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size. REPAIRING A FUSIBLE LINK IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient overload protection. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. Flat Wire Repairs FLAT WIRE REPAIRS NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced. GMLAN Wiring Repairs GMLAN WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The GM Local Area Network (GMLAN) System requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working on GMLAN connectors and terminals. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items in order to repair the GMLAN wiring: Dura Seal splice sleeves - A wire stripping tool - J 38125-8 Crimping Tool (GM P/N 12085115) - J 38125-5 Ultra Torch Special Tool (GM P/N 12085116) The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. - A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors GMLAN REPAIRS IMPORTANT: When making a repair to any GMLAN network, the original wire length after the repair must be the same length as before the repair. If the network is a twisted pair, the twist must be maintained after the repair is completed. GMLAN has 2 types of networks, low speed and high speed. Low speed GMLAN has a single wire and works at slow speeds. High speed GMLAN has 2 wires in a twisted pair and works at higher speeds. For more information on GMLAN, refer to Data Link Communications Description and Operation. GMLAN CONNECTOR TERMINAL REPAIR IMPORTANT: A service terminal can be used to replace damaged connector terminals for both high speed and low speed GMLAN systems. When making a connector terminal repair on a GMLAN high speed system with twisted pair wires, do not untwist the wires more than necessary to make the repair. The terminals in the GMLAN system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are available in the J-38125. If the individual terminals are damaged on any GMLAN connection, use the appropriate connector repair procedure in order to repair the terminal. GMLAN WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 439 If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs SIR/SRS WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS, and the wiring components, such as connectors and terminals. IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system terminals. Use either an SIR/SRS pigtail or a terminated lead from the SIR Repair Kit Tray. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves, in order to repair the SIR/SRS wiring - A special crimping tool - A heat torch - An instruction manual The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides the necessary low resistance contact integrity for these sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors SIR/SRS CONNECTOR REPAIR (PLASTIC BODY AND TERMINAL METAL PIN) The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made with a special plating. This plating provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. Use the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit for repairing SIR/SRS terminals and connectors. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the repair kit. The J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit contains: Various terminated leads for sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) terminal replacement - Various connector positive assurance (CPA) locks for SIR/SRS connectors - Base of steering column pigtail connectors part number 12085514 - Yellow vinyl electrical tape Pigtail repair packs are available for SIR/SRS connectors with eight or less terminals. Only the connector body is available for connectors with more than eight terminals. The terminated leads in the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit can be used to replace damaged terminals when replacing the connector body. SIR/SRS COMPONENT WIRE PIGTAIL REPAIR IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails. A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device, not by a connector. If a wiring pigtail is damaged, you must replace the entire component, with pigtail. The inflatable restraint steering wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component. SIR/SRS WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Capacity Specifications Refrigerant: Capacity Specifications Refrigerant System Capacities Page 3646 Some customers may use penetrating oils, grease or other lubricants on wheel studs to aid in removal or installation. Always use a suitable cleaner/solvent to remove these lubricants prior to installing the wheel and tire assemblies. Lubricants left on the wheel studs may cause improper readings of wheel nut torque. Always install wheels to clean, dry wheel studs ONLY. Notice Lubricants left on the wheel studs or vertical mounting surfaces between the wheel and the rotor or drum may cause the wheel to work itself loose after the vehicle is driven. Always install wheels to clean, dry wheel studs and surfaces ONLY. Beginning with 2011 model year vehicles, put a light coating of grease, GM P/N 1051344 (in Canada, P/N 9930370), on the inner surface of the wheel pilot hole to prevent wheel seizure to the axle or bearing hub. Wheel Stud and Lug Nut Damage Always inspect the wheel studs and lug nuts for signs of damage from crossthreading or abuse. You should never have to force wheel nuts down the stud. Lug nuts that are damaged may not retain properly, yet give the impression of fully tightening. Always inspect and replace any component suspected of damage. Tip Always start wheel nuts by hand! Be certain that all wheel nut threads have been engaged BEFORE tightening the nut. Important If the vehicle has directional tread tires, verify the directional arrow on the outboard side of the tire is pointing in the direction of forward rotation. Wheel Nut Tightening and Torque Improper wheel nut tightening can lead to brake pulsation and rotor damage. In order to avoid additional brake repairs, evenly tighten the wheel nuts to the proper torque specification as shown for each vehicle in SI. Always observe the proper wheel nut tightening sequence as shown below in order to avoid trapping the wheel on the wheel stud threads or clamping the wheel slightly off center resulting in vibration. The Most Important Service You Provide While the above information is well known, and wheel removal so common, technicians run the risk of becoming complacent on this very important Page 5843 REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. The release tab is located on the top of the wiredress cover. View of connector in released position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Page 6358 3. Remove the dress cover by using a flat-blade tool to release the connector locking tabs and pulling off the dress cover. 4. Relieve the tension on the nose piece retainers by inserting J-38125-12A (12094429) into the single retainer slot on the end of the nose piece and gently prying out the locking tab. Repeat the process for both of the nose piece locking tabs on the opposite side of the nose piece. Page 2416 Page 8400 - JST connectors have JST in small letters on their connectors, similar to that above. The location of the logo will vary with the connector size and style. - Kostel has an "LK" with a circle around it. These connector are usually used as a transmissions connection and are currently use on some Cadillac vehicles. Page 4668 If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs SIR/SRS WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS, and the wiring components, such as connectors and terminals. IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system terminals. Use either an SIR/SRS pigtail or a terminated lead from the SIR Repair Kit Tray. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves, in order to repair the SIR/SRS wiring - A special crimping tool - A heat torch - An instruction manual The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides the necessary low resistance contact integrity for these sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors SIR/SRS CONNECTOR REPAIR (PLASTIC BODY AND TERMINAL METAL PIN) The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made with a special plating. This plating provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. Use the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit for repairing SIR/SRS terminals and connectors. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the repair kit. The J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit contains: Various terminated leads for sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) terminal replacement - Various connector positive assurance (CPA) locks for SIR/SRS connectors - Base of steering column pigtail connectors part number 12085514 - Yellow vinyl electrical tape Pigtail repair packs are available for SIR/SRS connectors with eight or less terminals. Only the connector body is available for connectors with more than eight terminals. The terminated leads in the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit can be used to replace damaged terminals when replacing the connector body. SIR/SRS COMPONENT WIRE PIGTAIL REPAIR IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails. A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device, not by a connector. If a wiring pigtail is damaged, you must replace the entire component, with pigtail. The inflatable restraint steering wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component. SIR/SRS WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 8836 7. The illustration above identifies the entry canal where the terminal release tool will be inserted, and the terminal cavity. - Terminal (1) - Entry Canal (2) 8. Insert the J-38125-553 (15315247) tool into the entry canal and pry up on the terminal retainer. The terminal retainer is a small plastic piece on the top of the terminal. The terminal retainer must be held up while the terminal is pulled out of the connector. Page 4575 Page 8898 It is very important to use the correct test adapter when testing for proper terminal contact of fuses and relays in a bussed electrical center (BEC). Use J-35616-35 to test for proper terminal contact. Failure to use J-35616-35 can result in improper diagnosis of the BEC. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Separate the connector halves. 2. Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body. 3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J-38125 , test that the retention force is significantly different between a good terminal and a suspect terminal. Replace the female terminal in question. FLAT WIRE (DOCK AND LOCK) CONNECTORS There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock) connectors on the harness side or the component side. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Remove the component in question. 2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side of the connector as oil from your skin may be a source of contamination as well. 3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other imperfections that could cause poor terminal contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are uniform and free of damage or deformation. 4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the on the flat wire harness connector in order to test the circuit in question. CONTROL MODULE/COMPONENT VOLTAGE AND GROUNDS Poor voltage or ground connections can cause widely varying symptoms. Test all control module voltage supply circuits. Many vehicles have multiple circuits supplying voltage to a control module. Other components in the system may have separate voltage supply circuits that may also need to be tested. Inspect connections at the module/component connectors, fuses, and any intermediate connections between the voltage source and the module/component. A test lamp or a DMM may indicate that voltage is present, but neither tests the ability of the circuit to carry sufficient current. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Power Distribution Schematics. - Test all control module ground and system ground circuits. The control module may have multiple ground circuits. Other components in the system may have separate grounds that may also need to be tested. Inspect grounds for clean and tight connections at the grounding point. Inspect the connections at the component and in splice packs, where applicable. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Ground Distribution Schematics. TEMPERATURE SENSITIVITY - An intermittent condition may occur when a component/connection reaches normal operating temperature. The condition may occur only when the component/connection is cold, or only when the component/connection is hot. - Freeze Frame, Failure Records, Snapshot, or Vehicle Data Recorder data may help with this type of intermittent condition, where applicable. - If the intermittent is related to heat, review the data for a relationship with the following: High ambient temperatures - Underhood/engine generated heat - Circuit generated heat due to a poor connection, or high electrical load - Higher than normal load conditions, towing, etc. - If the intermittent is related to cold, review the data for the following: Low ambient temperatures-In extremely low temperatures, ice may form in a connection or component. Inspect for water intrusion. - The condition only occurs on a cold start. - The condition goes away when the vehicle warms up. - Information from the customer may help to determine if the trouble follows a pattern that is temperature related. - If temperature is suspected of causing an intermittent fault condition, attempt to duplicate the condition. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required. ELECTROMAGNETIC INTERFERENCE (EMI) AND ELECTRICAL NOISE Some electrical components/circuits are sensitive to electromagnetic interference (EMI) or other types of electrical noise. Inspect for the following conditions: A misrouted harness that is too close to high voltage/high current devices such as secondary ignition components, motors, generator etc-These components may induce electrical noise on a circuit that could interfere with normal circuit operation. - Electrical system interference caused by a malfunctioning relay, or a control module driven solenoid or switch-These conditions can cause a sharp electrical surge. Normally, the condition will occur when the malfunctioning component is operating. - Improper installation of non-factory or aftermarket add on accessories such as lights, 2-way radios, amplifiers, electric motors, remote starters, alarm systems, cell phones, etc-These accessories may lead to interference while in use, but do not fail when the accessories are not in use. - Test for an open diode across the A/C compressor clutch and for other open diodes. Some relays may contain a clamping diode. - The generator may be allowing AC noise into the electrical system. INCORRECT CONTROL MODULE - There are only a few situations where reprogramming a control module is appropriate: A new service control module is installed. Page 8064 The engine harness may be repaired using the J-38125. High Temperature Wiring Repairs HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperatures, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time may use materials i.e. wires, connectors, and shielding that has a higher heat rating than typical wiring. When making a repair in a high temperature area observe the following: Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature to replace any damaged wire. - Replace any heat shielding that is removed. - Cover any DuraSeal splice sleeves with SCT1 shrink tubing (available in the J-38125 Terminal Repair kit). - After making a wiring repair, ensure that the location of the wiring is not moved closer to the heat source. IDENTIFYING HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperature, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time need special considerations when making wiring repairs. Areas that may be exposed to higher temperatures can be identified by heat resistant materials that are being used in those areas. These materials may include heat reflective tape, moon tape, and high temperature shrink tubing. Also conduit and other protective coverings may be used. Because conduit or similar coverings are used throughout the vehicle regardless of the temperature, it may be necessary for the technician to determine if an area is exposed to excessive heat before making a wiring repair. Obvious areas of consideration would be any area located near the exhaust manifolds, catalytic converter, and exhaust pipes. The J-38125 contains much of the material you will need to perform repairs on areas exposed to high heat. The kit contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves to crimp and seal connections - High temperature SCT1 shrink tubing to protect the splice sleeves - A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct crimp tool to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools to remove the terminals from the connectors The J-38125 does not contain wire that is suitable to high temperature exposure. Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature of the same or larger gage size as the original wire when repair damage wire. Also replace any reflective tape that you remove during the repair. HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature rating of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125 and then encapsulate the splice sleeve using the high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the order listed. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip keeping all of the wire strands intact. Page 4912 - JST connectors have JST in small letters on their connectors, similar to that above. The location of the logo will vary with the connector size and style. - Kostel has an "LK" with a circle around it. These connector are usually used as a transmissions connection and are currently use on some Cadillac vehicles. Page 5609 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the DuraSeal splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of a connector. CPAs are used in all SIR System connectors and also in some connectors of other systems. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals of a connection. TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE CLIPS IMPORTANT: When making a splice in an area that may be exposed to moisture use a crimp and seal splice sleeve instead of a Splice Clip. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. Page 257 The engine harness may be repaired using the J-38125. High Temperature Wiring Repairs HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperatures, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time may use materials i.e. wires, connectors, and shielding that has a higher heat rating than typical wiring. When making a repair in a high temperature area observe the following: Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature to replace any damaged wire. - Replace any heat shielding that is removed. - Cover any DuraSeal splice sleeves with SCT1 shrink tubing (available in the J-38125 Terminal Repair kit). - After making a wiring repair, ensure that the location of the wiring is not moved closer to the heat source. IDENTIFYING HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperature, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time need special considerations when making wiring repairs. Areas that may be exposed to higher temperatures can be identified by heat resistant materials that are being used in those areas. These materials may include heat reflective tape, moon tape, and high temperature shrink tubing. Also conduit and other protective coverings may be used. Because conduit or similar coverings are used throughout the vehicle regardless of the temperature, it may be necessary for the technician to determine if an area is exposed to excessive heat before making a wiring repair. Obvious areas of consideration would be any area located near the exhaust manifolds, catalytic converter, and exhaust pipes. The J-38125 contains much of the material you will need to perform repairs on areas exposed to high heat. The kit contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves to crimp and seal connections - High temperature SCT1 shrink tubing to protect the splice sleeves - A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct crimp tool to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools to remove the terminals from the connectors The J-38125 does not contain wire that is suitable to high temperature exposure. Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature of the same or larger gage size as the original wire when repair damage wire. Also replace any reflective tape that you remove during the repair. HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature rating of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125 and then encapsulate the splice sleeve using the high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the order listed. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip keeping all of the wire strands intact. Diagram Information and Instructions Throttle Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions Electrical Symbols Page 7407 The engine harness may be repaired using the J-38125. High Temperature Wiring Repairs HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperatures, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time may use materials i.e. wires, connectors, and shielding that has a higher heat rating than typical wiring. When making a repair in a high temperature area observe the following: Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature to replace any damaged wire. - Replace any heat shielding that is removed. - Cover any DuraSeal splice sleeves with SCT1 shrink tubing (available in the J-38125 Terminal Repair kit). - After making a wiring repair, ensure that the location of the wiring is not moved closer to the heat source. IDENTIFYING HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperature, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time need special considerations when making wiring repairs. Areas that may be exposed to higher temperatures can be identified by heat resistant materials that are being used in those areas. These materials may include heat reflective tape, moon tape, and high temperature shrink tubing. Also conduit and other protective coverings may be used. Because conduit or similar coverings are used throughout the vehicle regardless of the temperature, it may be necessary for the technician to determine if an area is exposed to excessive heat before making a wiring repair. Obvious areas of consideration would be any area located near the exhaust manifolds, catalytic converter, and exhaust pipes. The J-38125 contains much of the material you will need to perform repairs on areas exposed to high heat. The kit contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves to crimp and seal connections - High temperature SCT1 shrink tubing to protect the splice sleeves - A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct crimp tool to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools to remove the terminals from the connectors The J-38125 does not contain wire that is suitable to high temperature exposure. Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature of the same or larger gage size as the original wire when repair damage wire. Also replace any reflective tape that you remove during the repair. HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature rating of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125 and then encapsulate the splice sleeve using the high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the order listed. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip keeping all of the wire strands intact. Page 7356 View of the connector when released from the component. View of another type of Micro 64 connector. Page 2515 5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape. Seat Belt Schematic Icons Seat Belt Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons Page 8576 4. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the rear of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. 5. Once the locking tabs are unlocked, slide the inner connector out of the rear of the connector housing. Page 228 4. Slide the dress cover forward and off of the connector. 5. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front and rear of the connector. Page 5760 1. Install the CKP sensor. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Install the CKP sensor bolt. Tighten the bolt to 25 N.m (18 lb ft). 3. Connect the electrical connector (2) to the CKP sensor (1). 4. Install the starter. Page 8544 The first connector design of the Micro-Pack 100W (1) has a white connector interface that holds the terminals. The second design of the Micro-Pack 100W (2) has a gray interface to hold the terminals. Also, the first design has terminal cavities that are further apart (3 mm centerline) and offset from the other row of terminal cavities in the connector. The second design has terminals cavities that are closer together (2.54 mm centerline) and aligned vertically. One other way to identify the second design is the thin strip of material that runs along the outside of the cavities. IMPORTANT: There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W terminals which are very similar. Ensure that you have the correct terminal before crimping the new terminal to the wire. The first design connector uses the longer terminal (1) that has a raised area in front of the recess in the terminal. The second design connector uses the shorter terminal without the raised area. Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro-Pack 100W connectors. Some Micro-Pack 100W connector disassembly procedures will vary. Use this procedure as a guide. 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 8218 1. Locate the air flow direction arrow (2) on the MAF/IAT sensor. 2. Install the MAF/IAT sensor on to the air cleaner housing. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 3. Tighten the clamp securing the MAF/IAT sensor to the air cleaner housing. Tighten the clamp to 7 N.m (62 lb in). 4. Install the air cleaner outlet duct. 5. Install the air cleaner outlet duct bolt. Tighten the bolt to 10 N.m (89 lb in). 6. Tighten the clamps at the MAF/IAT sensor and the throttle body. Tighten the clamps to 7 N.m (62 lb in). Page 8805 View of the connector when released from the component. View of another type of Micro 64 connector. Page 5211 7. The illustration above identifies the entry canal where the terminal release tool will be inserted, and the terminal cavity. - Terminal (1) - Entry Canal (2) 8. Insert the J-38125-553 (15315247) tool into the entry canal and pry up on the terminal retainer. The terminal retainer is a small plastic piece on the top of the terminal. The terminal retainer must be held up while the terminal is pulled out of the connector. Page 1662 Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Crankshaft Position System Variation Learn Crankshaft Position System Variation Learn 1. Install a scan tool. 2. Monitor the engine control module (ECM) for DTCs with a scan tool. If other DTCs are set, except DTC P0315, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle in Vehicle DTC Information for the applicable DTC that set. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Descriptions 3. Select the crankshaft position (CKP) variation learn procedure with a scan tool. 4. The scan tool instructs you to perform the following: 1. Accelerate to wide open throttle (WOT). 2. Release throttle when fuel cut-off occurs. 3. Observe fuel cut-off for applicable engine. 4. Engine should not accelerate beyond calibrated RPM value. 5. Release throttle immediately if value is exceeded. 6. Block drive wheels. 7. Set parking brake. 8. DO NOT apply brake pedal. 9. Cycle ignition from OFF to ON. 10. Apply and hold brake pedal. 11. Start and idle engine. 12. Turn A/C OFF. 13. Vehicle must remain in Park or Neutral. 14. The scan tool monitors certain component signals to determine if all the conditions are met to continue with the procedure. The scan tool only displays the condition that inhibits the procedure. The scan tool monitors the following components: * CKP sensors activity-If there is a CKP sensor condition, refer to the applicable DTC that set. * Camshaft position (CMP) sensor activity-If there is a CMP sensor condition, refer to the applicable DTC that set. * Engine coolant temperature (ECT)-If the ECT is not warm enough, idle the engine until the engine coolant temperature reaches the correct temperature. 5. Enable the CKP system variation learn procedure with a scan tool. Important: While the learn procedure is in progress, release the throttle immediately when the engine starts to decelerate. The engine control is returned to the operator and the engine responds to throttle position after the learn procedure is complete. 6. Accelerate to WOT. 7. Release when the fuel cut-off occurs. 8. Test in progress 9. The scan tool displays Learn Status: Learned this ignition. If the scan tool indicates that DTC P0315 ran and passed, the CKP variation learn procedure is complete. If the scan tool indicates DTC P0315 failed or did not run, refer to DTC P0315. If any other DTCs set, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle in Vehicle DTC Information for the applicable DTC that set. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Descriptions See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/P Code Charts/P0315 10. Turn OFF the ignition for 30 seconds after the learn procedure is completed successfully. 11. The CKP system variation learn procedure is also required when the following service procedures have been performed, regardless of whether DTC P0315 is set: * A CKP sensor replacement * An engine replacement * A ECM replacement * A harmonic balancer replacement * A crankshaft replacement * Any engine repairs which disturb the CKP sensor relationship Page 6535 3. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. View showing depressing of the lever lock release tab. Page 7143 Page 7203 MOLEX CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. 2. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. Page 4705 Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Specifications Temperature Versus Resistance Page 181 Refer to the following table as a guide in selecting the correct test adapter for front probing connectors: Backprobe IMPORTANT: Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures. - Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector. - Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large of a test probe. - After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected, test for proper terminal contact. Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the connector. Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure SCAN TOOL SNAPSHOT PROCEDURE Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used Page 6098 2. Locate the nose piece locking tabs that are positioned on the side of the connector nose piece. The connector nose piece acts as a terminal positive assurance (TPA) and may be referred to as such. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to push in one of the locking tabs while gently pulling on the same side of the nose piece. 4. Repeat the procedure for the other locking tab and remove the nose piece. 5. Remove the wire dress cover. The following is a general procedure for wire dress cover removal. Use this procedure as a guide, some dress cover removal procedures may vary. 6. Use fingers to squeeze the 2 locking legs of the cover. Diagram Information and Instructions Radiator Cooling Fan Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions Electrical Symbols Page 8765 Page 5563 The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors. 1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position. 4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool J 38125-10A (GM P/N 12014012-1) into the front (mating end) of the connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal through the back of the connector (2). IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector. 6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. 7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily. 10. Perform system check. Delphi Connectors (12 Way) DELPHI CONNECTORS (12-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. Page 6252 4. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the rear of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. 5. Once the locking tabs are unlocked, slide the inner connector out of the rear of the connector housing. Page 307 Power Seat Control Module: Removal and Replacement MEMORY SEAT CONTROL MODULE REPLACEMENT REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Remove the 3 seat switch bezel screws. 2. Remove 4 nuts that attach the seat pan to the seat assembly. 3. Remove the clip from the front outboard seat pan stud. Discard the clip. 4. Lift the seat pan up in order to allow access to the seat control module retaining screw. 5. Remove the seat control module retaining screw. 6. Disconnect the electrical connectors from the seat control module as necessary. 7. Remove the seat control module from the seat assembly. INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 1. Align and install the locating tabs on the seat control module with the seat pan. 2. Connect the electrical connectors to the seat control module as necessary. 3. NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice. Install the screw that retains the seat control module to the seat pan. Tighten the screw to 3 N.m (26 lb in). 4. Install the seat pan to the seat assembly. Page 1629 4. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the rear of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. 5. Once the locking tabs are unlocked, slide the inner connector out of the rear of the connector housing. Page 1379 2. Use a small flat-bladed tool to release the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting the tool in the small recess on the side of the connector and pushing up until the TPA releases from the connector body. The TPA should raise just slightly. Do not try to remove the TPA. IMPORTANT: The TPA on this connector cannot be removed unless the terminals are removed first. The TPA will come out of the connector body, but only slightly. When the TPA is slightly raised the terminals can be removed. Using excessive force to remove the TPA with the terminals still in the connector will damage the connector. 3. Repeat the process for the other side of the connector. 4. Ensure that the TPA is in the proper position to remove the terminals. Page 2373 9. The illustration shows a cutaway view of the connector to aid the technician in releasing the terminal retainer. 10. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Terminal Position Assurance Locks TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Tyco/Amp Connectors (CM 42-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (CM 42-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the connector body and pull the CPA out. The CPA is on the wire harness side of connector. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 7326 Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Page 788 5. Insert the ECM into the retaining slots of the ECM/TCM bracket. 6. Secure the ECM to the bracket ensuring that the ECM retaining tabs (1) are fully engaged. 7. Connect the engine wiring harness electrical connectors to the ECM. Page 5480 Release the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the blue locking tabs on both ends of the connector. Gently slide the TPA up to the released position on both ends. 6. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-13A (GM P/N 12031876-1) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. Engine/Transmission - Aftermarket Calibrations Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine/Transmission - Aftermarket Calibrations INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 09-06-04-026C Date: August 13, 2010 Subject: Identifying Non-GM (Aftermarket) Engine and Transmission Calibrations for V8 Gas Engines Using Tech 2(R) or Global Diagnostic System (GDS) Models: 2006-2011 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Excluding Saab 9-7X) 2006-2009 HUMMER H2 2006-2010 HUMMER H3 Equipped with V8 Gas Powered Engines Only Attention: This bulletin applies to V8 gas powered engines ONLY. For Duramax(TM) diesel powered engines, refer to the latest version of Corporate Bulletin Number 08-06-04-006G. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2011 model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 09-06-04-026A (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). General Motors is identifying an increasing number of engine, transmission and catalytic converter part failures that are the result of non-GM (aftermarket) engine and transmission control calibrations being used. When alteration to the GM-released engine or transmission control calibrations occurs, it subjects powertrain and driveline components (engine , transmission, transfer case, driveshaft and rear axle) to stresses that were not tested by General Motors. It is because of these unknown stresses, and the potential to alter reliability, durability and emissions performance, that GM has adopted a policy that prevents any UNAUTHORIZED dealer warranty claim submissions to any remaining warranty coverage, to the powertrain and driveline components whenever the presence of a non-GM (aftermarket) calibration is confirmed - even if the non-GM control module calibration is subsequently removed. Warranty coverage is based on the equipment and calibrations that were released on the vehicle at time of sale, or subsequently updated by GM. That's because GM testing and validation matches the calibration to a host of criteria that is essential to assure reliability, durability and emissions performance over the life of the warranty coverage and beyond. Stresses resulting from calibrations different from those tested and released by GM can damage or weaken components, leading to poor performance and or shortened life. Additionally, non-GM (aftermarket) issued engine control modifications often do not meet the same emissions performance standards as GM issued calibrations. Depending on state statutes, individuals who install engine control module calibrations that put the vehicle outside the parameters of emissions certification standards may be subject to fines and/or penalties. This bulletin outlines a procedure to identify the presence of non-GM (aftermarket) calibrations. GM recommends performing this check whenever a hard part failure is seen on internal engine or transmission components, or before an engine assembly or transmission assembly is being replaced under warranty. It is also recommended that the engine calibration verification procedure be performed whenever diagnostics indicate that catalytic converter replacement is indicated. The PQC has a process to confirm the ECM/PCM calibration is GM issued. The PQC will require a picture of the engine calibration verification screen, as outlined in this bulletin, before authorizing any V8 gas powered engine replacement. If a non-GM calibration is found and verification has taken place through GM, the remaining powertrain and driveline warranty will be blocked and notated in GMVIS and the dealership will be notified. This block prevents any UNAUTHORIZED warranty claim submission. 1. Connect the Tech 2(R) to the vehicle. 2. Go to: Diagnostics and build the vehicle. 3. Select: Powertrain. 4. Select: Engine. 5. *Select: Engine Control Module or PCM. 6. *Select: Module ID Information or I/M Information System if the Module ID Information selection is not available. 7. *If "I/M information System" was selected, it may be necessary to select "Vehicle Information" in order to display the calibration information. ‹› If the CVN information is displayed as "N/A", it will be necessary to contact the TCSC to obtain the CVN information. Diagram Information and Instructions Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions Electrical Symbols Page 6751 Knock Sensor: Connector Views Engine Controls Connector End Views Knock Sensor (KS) 1 - Left Knock Sensor (KS) 2 - Right Page 386 Depress the locks that are located on both sides of the wiredress cover and pull the lever over and past the locks. View of the connector when released from the component. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the front of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool push down on one of the locking tabs and pull the cover up until the dress cover releases. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. Page 8027 Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. FCI Connectors FCI CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 429 6. Gently pry the plastic terminal retainer down and carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (16-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, pull the two connector halves apart. Page 5518 Page 8465 5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape. Seat Belt Schematic Icons Seat Belt Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons Page 4566 US English/Metric Conversion US English/Metric Conversion Page 8292 8. Insert the J 38125-213 into the small terminal release hole on the nose piece and gently pull on the back of the wire. 9. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Repairing Connector Terminals REPAIRING CONNECTOR TERMINALS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following: Push to Seat terminals - Pull to Seat terminals Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your terminal repair. The J-38125 contains further information. 1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.For cable seal terminals, remove the seal. 2. Apply the correct cable seal per gage size of the wire, if used.Slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation removal. 3. Remove the insulation. 4. For sealed terminals only, align the seal with the end of the cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal.For sealed terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal. 6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.For sealed terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable. 8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals excepting Micro-Pack 100.64 size. Soldering Micro-Pack 100 World terminals may damage the terminal. Sumitomo Connectors SUMITOMO CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 1489 2. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 3441 5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape. Seat Belt Schematic Icons Seat Belt Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons Page 5640 7. Wrap electrical tape around the connection as shown. 8. Route the engine coolant heater cord and extension cord behind the alternator and adjacent to the engine coolant crossover pipe as shown. 9. Continue to route the extension cord to the exit location desired by the customer as shown. 10. Review the routing of the coolant heater cord and extension cord to verify that it does not touch any sharp edges that could damage it. 11. Secure the engine coolant heater cord and the extension cord with tie straps as needed. 12. Resecure any of the original clips that retained the engine coolant heater cord to the vehicle that were released to provide length. Part Information The extension cord may be obtained at any of the following outlets: - Lowes* - Home Depot* - Canada: Acklands-Grainger* (www.acklandsgrainger.com), Catalogue Part Number: CWRSJTOW3C14-10 USA: Cords should bear the UL symbol. Canada: Cords should bear the ULc symbol or CSA approval. *We believe these sources and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume any responsibility for the products or material from these firms or for any such items that may be available from other sources. Page 4961 2. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully push the terminal position assurance (TPA) towards the face of the connector on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA is fragile and may break if not done carefully. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. 3. Use the J 38125-215 tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 6356 8. Insert the J 38125-213 into the small terminal release hole on the nose piece and gently pull on the back of the wire. 9. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Repairing Connector Terminals REPAIRING CONNECTOR TERMINALS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following: Push to Seat terminals - Pull to Seat terminals Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your terminal repair. The J-38125 contains further information. 1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.For cable seal terminals, remove the seal. 2. Apply the correct cable seal per gage size of the wire, if used.Slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation removal. 3. Remove the insulation. 4. For sealed terminals only, align the seal with the end of the cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal.For sealed terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal. 6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.For sealed terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable. 8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals excepting Micro-Pack 100.64 size. Soldering Micro-Pack 100 World terminals may damage the terminal. Sumitomo Connectors SUMITOMO CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Body Wiring Harness Extension Replacement Body Control Module: Service and Repair Body Wiring Harness Extension Replacement BODY WIRING HARNESS EXTENSION REPLACEMENT - BCM REMOVAL PROCEDURE IMPORTANT: The ignition switch should be in the OFF position when connecting or disconnecting the connectors to the body control module (BCM). - Always disconnect the 40-way body wiring extension FIRST, the 32-way tan connector SECOND and the 24-way gray electrical connector LAST. - Always connect the 24-way gray electrical connector FIRST, the 32-way tan connector SECOND and the 40-way body wiring extension LAST. - The BCM can set DTCs with the ignition switch in the OFF position. The BCM has battery run down protection for the courtesy lamp circuit. The BCM battery run down protection cannot detect shorts on inputs or other circuits which the BCM does not control. Use the scan tool in order to activate the POWER DOWN NOW mode. Use the POWER DOWN NOW mode in order to check for current draws on circuits that are not controlled by the BCM, or controlled by the battery run down protection system. - Do not touch the exposed electrical contacts of the body wiring extension. 1. CAUTION: Refer to Battery Disconnect Caution. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. If replacing the body wiring harness extension on a Chevrolet Trail Blazer EXT or GMC Envoy XL, remove the left second row seat. 3. If replacing the body wiring harness extension on a Chevrolet TrailBlazer or GMC Envoy, position the left hand second seat to a cargo position. 4. Remove the rear electrical center cover. 5. Press down and hold the locking tab (1). 6. Disengage the sliding latch retaining the BCM to the rear electrical center.Slide the latch inboard until fully extended, approximately 40 mm (1.6 in). 7. Disconnect the body wiring extension (1) from the BCM. Page 2581 - Kostel - Molex - Sumitomo - Tyco/AMP - Yazaki Identifying the manufacturer of a connector is often difficult. When trying to determine the manufacturer of a connector, look for specific identifying marks that are unique to that connector supplier. Most of these identify marks are hard to find or see. Check the connector carefully and refer to the information below for pictures and descriptions of connector identification markings. - Most of AFLs connectors have EPC on their connector body. Some of the smaller connectors will not have any markings on them. - In some cases Bosch will actually be printed on the connector. If Bosch does not appear on the connector, look for the Bosch logo. The Bosch logo is a circle with a blunted arrow inside. This logo can appear anywhere on the connector and is often very small. Page 558 Page 2856 2. Tighten the rear lower control arm bracket mounting bolts to 240 N.m (177 lb ft). 3. Verify that the caster and the camber are still within specifications. Refer to Wheel Alignment Specifications. 4. When the caster and camber are within specifications, adjust the toe. Refer to Front Toe Adjustment. Page 4534 5. Once the nose piece retainers are relaxed, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should raise slightly. 6. On the opposite side of the nose piece, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should release completely. If the nose piece does not come off, repeat the procedure on the opposite side. Page 1456 4. Once the front 2 locks are unlocked, lift the front of the dress cover and pull it forward. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the small slot on the TPA and pushing down until the TPA releases. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to angle or rock the J 38125-21 tool when inserting it into the connector or the tool may break. Insert the J 38125-21 (GM P/N 15381651-2) tool into the round canal between the terminals cavities at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to repair Micro 64 connector terminals. The Micro 64 connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-64 (M jaw) was developed to crimp Micro 64 terminals. The J 38125-64 crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. The J 38125-64 crimping tool is also designed to crimp both the wire and the insulation at the same time. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro 64 terminals. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. 1. Cut the wire as close to the damaged terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. Page 8690 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) and slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. Page 8193 View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. View of the release tool being used for the smaller terminals. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (2-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 2305 Page 7047 pulling it through. This will prevent damage to the internal seals of the connector. Once the terminal is pushed out of the connector, cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible and pull the wire through the connector. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE The Micro-Pack 100W connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool was developed to crimp Micro-Pack 100W terminals. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 2. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert the terminal into the crimp tool until the core wings are flush with the anvil on the crimp tool. Be sure that the wings are pointed toward the crimp tool former and release the spring locator. The locator will hold the terminal in place. Inspect the alignment of the terminal wings with the crimp tool former. If the terminal wings are wider than the crimp tool former, remove the terminal and bend the terminal wings in slightly. 5. Place stripped wire into terminal. 6. Crimp the new terminal to the wire. If a jam occurs, press the emergency release to open applicator. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire perform the following procedure in order to replace Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. Page 7196 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. JST Connectors JST CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, remove the connector from the component. Page 1051 Seat Position Sensor - Rear (w/Memory) Page 2114 - Most Molex connectors will have the Molex logo on the dresscover of the connector. In some cases the connectors may have MX followed by another letter. The third letter indicates where the connector was made. A connector with MXD is a Molex connector made in Detroit. Sumitomo has a unique symbol on their connector and possibly a part number. The symbol is similar to that of a diamond lying on its side, similar to that shown. The logo could appear anywhere but the most common place is at the wire side of the housing. Tyco/AMP has many different and unique connector designs. Some may or may not have identifiable marks on them. Page 1853 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (BSK) BOSCH CONNECTORS (BSK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 3. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 4. Insert the J 38125-561 tool into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 5. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is Page 8790 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (BSK) BOSCH CONNECTORS (BSK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 3. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 4. Insert the J 38125-561 tool into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 5. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is Page 5708 4. Use a small flat-blade tool to slide the terminal position assurance (TPA) up one notch on both ends of the connector. The TPA is located underneath the wire dress cover. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Engine - Valve Lifter Tick Noise At Start Up Engine Oil: Customer Interest Engine - Valve Lifter Tick Noise At Start Up TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 10-06-01-007C Date: February 09, 2011 Subject: Active Fuel Management (AFM) Engine, Valve Lifter Tick Noise at Start Up When Engine Has Been Off for 2 Hours or More (Evaluate Noise and/or Replace Valve Lifters) Models: 2007 Buick Rainier 2009 Buick LaCrosse Super, Allure Super (Canada Only) 2007 Cadillac Escalade Built Prior to April 1, 2006 with 6.2L Engine RPO L92 (These engines were built with AFM Hardware but the AFM system was disabled) 2010-2011 Cadillac Escalade, Escalade ESV, Escalade EXT 2007 Chevrolet Monte Carlo 2007-2009 Chevrolet Impala 2007-2011 Chevrolet Avalanche, Silverado, Suburban, Tahoe, TrailBlazer, TrailBlazer EXT 2010-2011 Chevrolet Camaro SS 2007-2011 GMC Envoy, Envoy XL, Sierra, Yukon, Yukon Denali, Yukon XL, Yukon XL Denali 2007-2008 Pontiac Grand Prix 2008-2009 Pontiac G8 2007-2009 Saab 9-7X Equipped with AFM (Active Fuel Management) and V8 Engine RPO L76, L94, L99, LC9, LFA, LH6, LMG, LS4, LY5 or LZ1 Attention: This bulletin only applies to the AFM V8 engines listed above. It DOES NOT apply to Non-AFM Engines. If you are dealing with a Non-AFM engine that is experiencing a similar noise, please refer to Engine Mechanical > Diagnostic Information and Procedures > Symptoms in SI. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add models. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 10-06-01-007B (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). Condition Some customers may comment on an engine valve lifter tick noise that occurs after the engine has been shut off for at least two hours. The tick noise may last from two seconds to ten minutes. Cause This condition may be caused by any of the following: - Aerated oil in the valve lifter body, resulting in the valve lifter being unable to purge the air quickly. - A low engine oil level or incorrect oil viscosity. - Dirty or contaminated oil. - A low internal valve lifter oil reservoir level. - Debris in the valve lifter. - A high valve lifter leak down rate. Correction If the SI diagnostics do not isolate the cause of this valve lifter tick noise and normal oil pressure is noted during the concern, perform the following steps: 1. Inspect the engine oil condition and level. Refer to Owner Manual > Service and Appearance Care > Checking Things Under the Hood > Description and Operation > Engine Oil in SI. ‹› If the engine oil is more than one quart low, an incorrect oil viscosity is being used or if poor quality/contamination is observed, change the oil and filter. Note Page 8704 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. 4. Remove the dress cover by using a flat bladed tool to release the dress cover locking tabs and lift up on the dress cover. 5. Cut the tie wrap that holds the wires to the connector body. Page 6064 Checking Aftermarket Accessories CHECKING AFTERMARKET ACCESSORIES Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits: - CAUTION: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol. - NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice. OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol. Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the cause of the problems. Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include: Power feeds connected to points other than the battery - Antenna location - Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring - Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line - Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories. Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions INDUCING INTERMITTENT FAULT CONDITIONS TOOLS REQUIRED J 25070 Heat Gun Many intermittent open or shorted circuits are affected by harness/connector movement that is caused by vibration, engine torque, bumps/rough pavement, etc. In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness if the malfunction appears to be Page 869 MOLEX CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. 2. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. Page 1910 View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. View of the release tool being used for the smaller terminals. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (2-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 5292 to analyze the data during the time a vehicle condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a trigger point that you have determined. Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2 snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a first-in, first-out basis. If a third snapshot is taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost. Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types: Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice - Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200 frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not lost if the Scan Tool is powered down. The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis. The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected values by plotting 3 parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful, especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC. Testing for a Short to Voltage TESTING FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4. Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt, there is a short to voltage in the circuit. Testing for Continuity TESTING FOR CONTINUITY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6. Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit. 7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity. With a Test Lamp IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits. 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6. If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity. Testing for Electrical Intermittents TESTING FOR ELECTRICAL INTERMITTENTS Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment. - Testing for Short to Ground - Testing for Continuity - Testing for a Short to Voltage Page 8114 Diagram Information and Instructions Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions Electrical Symbols Page 1355 REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. The release tab is located on the top of the wiredress cover. View of connector in released position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Page 6055 Page 862 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. JST Connectors JST CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, remove the connector from the component. Page 9012 If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200 DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J 39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected. IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J 39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and maximum (MAX) values measured. 1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of a suspected circuit to the other. 2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J 39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep). IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value in order to record the full change. 5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling the connections or the wiring, test driving, or performing other operations. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions. 6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9. Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist. Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections TESTING FOR INTERMITTENT CONDITIONS AND POOR CONNECTIONS TOOLS REQUIRED - J 35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit - J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit When the condition is not currently present, but is indicated in DTC history, the cause may be intermittent. An intermittent may also be the cause when there is a customer complaint, but the symptom cannot be duplicated. Refer to the Symptom Table of the system that is suspect of causing the condition before trying to locate an intermittent condition. Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the following items: Wiring broken inside the insulation - Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector - Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself, and corrosion in the wire to terminal contact area, etc. - Pierced or damaged insulation can allow moisture to enter the wiring causing corrosion. The conductor can corrode inside the insulation, with little visible evidence. Look for swollen and stiff sections of wire in the suspect circuits. - Wiring which has been pinched, cut, or its insulation rubbed through may cause an intermittent open or short as the bare area touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle. - Wiring that comes in contact with hot or exhaust components - Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required, in order to verify the customer concern. - Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. - Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis and Vehicle Data Recorder operation. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any inline connectors before replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation. Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination, usually in the underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit. Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper adapter. Always use the J 35616 when probing connectors. Other causes of terminal deformation are improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT IN BUSSED ELECTRICAL CENTERS (BEC) Page 4179 Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 4. Install the intake manifold bolts. 1. Tighten the bolts a first pass in sequence to 5 N.m (44 lb in). 2. Tighten the bolts a final pass in sequence to 10 N.m (89 lb in). 5. Route the electrical harness into position over the engine. 6. Install the engine harness bracket nut (1). Tighten the nut to 10 N.m (89 lb in). Page 8933 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the TPA. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the nose piece. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. Page 6890 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. 4. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front of the connector. Page 5340 MOLEX CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. 2. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. Page 6448 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Ensure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the Terminal Removal Procedure. Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PULL TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL If the terminal is visibly damaged or is suspected of having a faulty connection, the terminal should be replaced. Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors: 1. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) device and/or the secondary lock. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component or separate the connectors for in-line connectors. 3. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device. 4. Insert the proper pick or removal tool into the front of the connector body. 5. IMPORTANT: On connectors with more than one terminal the service loop may not be large enough to remove the terminal and crimp on a new one. If the terminal wire does not have a large enough service loop for removal, cut the wire 5 cm (2 in) behind the connector before removal. Grasp the wire at the back of the connector body and gently push the terminal out the front of the connector body. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. If the wire needed to be cut in order to remove the terminal, gently push a small length of the same size wire through the back of the connector cavity until there is enough wire exposed in order to crimp on a new terminal. If the wire was not cut, cut the existing wire as close to the old terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 4. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. TERMINAL INSTALLATION 1. Align the terminal and pull the wire from the back of the connector in order to seat the terminal. 2. If necessary, cut the new wire to proper length and splice with existing circuit. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. 3. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply dielectric grease to the connector. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PUSH TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 618 6. Engage the sliding latch fastening the BCM to the rear electrical center. Slide the latch outboard until the locking tab (1) is fully seated. 7. Install the rear electrical center cover. 8. If replacing the BCM on a Chevrolet TrailBlazer or GMC Envoy, position the left hand second seat to a passenger position. 9. If replacing the BCM on a Chevrolet TrailBlazer EXT or GMC Envoy XL, install the left second row seat. 10. Connect the negative battery cable. 11. If installing a replacement BCM, program the BCM. Refer to Control Module References. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Page 7188 TERMINAL REMOVAL Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors. 1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA) device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1). 3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 4. Gently pull the cable and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector. 5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal, refer to Terminal Repair. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3. Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector. REINSTALLING TERMINAL 1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly, refer to Wiring Repairs. 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3. Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) DELPHI CONNECTORS (WEATHER PACK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 5481 View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. View of the release tool being used for the smaller terminals. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (2-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 376 11. Insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) into the 2 triangular cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 12. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE 1. Prior to installation the terminal must be aligned so the (1) coding lugs align with the (2) coding grooves on the connector. 2. Once the terminal is aligned, slide the terminal into the cavity until the retainer has engaged in the cavity of the connector. 3. Slide the TPA in the connector body and seat it using a small flat bladed tool. The TPA is seated when it is flush with the contact housing. 4. Secure the wires to the connector body using a tie wrap and replace the dress cover and grommet. Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) BOSCH CONNECTORS (2.8 JPT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Pull out the slider on the connector position assurance (CPA) until it is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 6559 7. Apply pressure and gently rock the cover until one locking leg is unseated. 8. Continue to apply pressure and rock the cover until the second locking leg is unseated. Repeat procedure for the other side of the dress cover and remove the cover. 9. Use J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) to gently lift the terminal retaining tab while gently pulling the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 10. If the terminal is severely bent or damaged, it may be possible on some connectors to push the wire out of the front of the connector instead of Page 7117 20. Extract a portion of the ECT sensor harness wiring and connector from the protective conduit. Cut off the ECT sensor harness connector and wiring. 21. Determine a routing path for the ECT sensor jumper harness wires so that they can be secured TO or WITHIN an existing protective conduit. Note This step is to set up and verify the length of wiring that is required before cutting. 22. Route the ECT sensor jumper wires and then enclose them in their own protective conduit in order to VERIFY the length that is required. 23. Cut the ECT sensor jumper wires to the appropriate length. Note Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splice or connector. 24. Splice the ECT sensor jumper wires to the ORIGINAL ECT HARNESS LOCATION using DuraSeal weatherproof splices. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves in SI. Note Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splice or connector. 25. Splice the ECT sensor jumper wires to the ECT SENSOR HARNESS CONNECTOR using DuraSeal weatherproof splices. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves in SI. 26. Connect the ECT sensor harness connector to the ECT sensor. 27. Secure the ECT sensor jumper wires that are in their own protective conduit TO or WITHIN the existing harness conduit using tie straps. Important You MUST run the engine at the specified RPM and until it reaches normal operating temperature and then allow it to idle as indicated in SI. The engine MUST then be allowed to cool down in order to top off the coolant level as needed. 28. Fill the cooling system to the proper level. Refer to Cooling System Draining and Filling in SI. 29. Pressure test the cooling system. Refer to Cooling System Leak Testing in SI. 30. Use a scan tool to clear any DTCs. Relocating the Engine Coolant Heater Cord Important For reference, the procedure and graphics that are shown are from a Chevrolet Silverado, but are similar for the other vehicles listed above. 1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Ask the customer where they would prefer the extension cord to exit from the engine compartment in order to determine the required extension cord length. 3. Obtain an extension cord with the following features: - 120 volt - 14/3 gauge - 15A capacity - Three prong - Polarized plug and receptacle - Chemical resistant - Grounded terminals - Designed for use in a cold outdoor environment - Outer jacket resistant to deterioration from moisture, abrasion and exposure to sunlight - Maximum length of 2.5-3 m (8-10 ft) 4. Release enough of the clips that retain the engine coolant heater cord to the vehicle to provide the necessary length for repositioning. 5. Apply dielectric grease to the electrical contacts of the heater cord receptacle and the extension cord plug to prevent corrosion. Use GM P/N 12345579 (in Canada, use P/N 10953481) or an equivalent. 6. Connect the heater cord receptacle to the extension cord plug and wipe OFF any excess grease. Page 3833 Important: ^ Properly locate the camshaft sprocket locating pin with the camshaft sprocket alignment hole. ^ The sprocket teeth and timing chain must mesh. ^ The camshaft and the crankshaft sprocket alignment marks MUST be aligned properly. Locate the camshaft sprocket alignment mark in the 6 o'clock position. If necessary, rotate the camshaft or crankshaft sprockets in order to align the timing marks. 6. Install the camshaft sprocket and the timing chain. 7. Install the camshaft sprocket bolts. Tighten the bolts to 35 N.m (26 lb ft). Page 7643 The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors. 1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position. 4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool J 38125-10A (GM P/N 12014012-1) into the front (mating end) of the connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal through the back of the connector (2). IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector. 6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. 7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily. 10. Perform system check. Delphi Connectors (12 Way) DELPHI CONNECTORS (12-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. Page 3688 Note: The vehicles shown must not be towed backwards or transmission damage may occur. Towing Procedure Note: Failure to follow these instructions may result in damage to the transmission. Important: The towing speed as stated in the Owner's Manual should not exceed 104 km/h (65 mph) for 1995-2005 vehicles. In order to properly dinghy tow the vehicle, follow these steps: 1. Firmly set the parking brake. 2. Open the fuse panel and pull the fuse(s) indicated in the Owner's Manual section detailing towing your vehicle. This prevents the instrument panel (IP) and/or electronic PRNDL indicator from draining the battery. 3. Securely attach the vehicle to the tow vehicle. 4. Turn the ignition key to the OFF position, which is one position forward of LOCK. Unlocking the steering column allows for proper movement of the front wheels and tires during towing. For 1997-1999 Cutlass, 1997-2003 Malibu, 2004-2006 Chevrolet Classic and 1999-2004 Alero/Grand Am models, turn the ignition switch to the accessory (ACC) position, which is one position forward of OFF. This position unlocks the transaxle. 5. Shift the transmission to Neutral (N). Note: Page 2630 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert a small flat-blade tool in the slot below the front loaded terminal position assurance (TPA) and pry up. 3. Remove the TPA by pulling it out of the connector. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-553 (GM P/N 15315247) on a slight upward angle into the cavity below the terminal to be removed. Ensure that the pointed on the end of the tool is facing the bottom of the terminal and it stays in contact with the terminal until it stops on the plastic terminal retainer. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 7871 Body Control Module (BCM) C3 Page 720 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) and slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. Locations Knock Sensor: Locations Engine Controls Component Views Lower Left Side of Engine - Rear 1 - G108 2 - Knock Sensor (KS) 1 - Left 3 - Engine 4 - G107 5 - Engine Harness Lower Right Side of the Engine - Rear Page 4591 If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200 DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J 39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected. IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J 39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and maximum (MAX) values measured. 1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of a suspected circuit to the other. 2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J 39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep). IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value in order to record the full change. 5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling the connections or the wiring, test driving, or performing other operations. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions. 6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9. Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist. Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections TESTING FOR INTERMITTENT CONDITIONS AND POOR CONNECTIONS TOOLS REQUIRED - J 35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit - J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit When the condition is not currently present, but is indicated in DTC history, the cause may be intermittent. An intermittent may also be the cause when there is a customer complaint, but the symptom cannot be duplicated. Refer to the Symptom Table of the system that is suspect of causing the condition before trying to locate an intermittent condition. Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the following items: Wiring broken inside the insulation - Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector - Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself, and corrosion in the wire to terminal contact area, etc. - Pierced or damaged insulation can allow moisture to enter the wiring causing corrosion. The conductor can corrode inside the insulation, with little visible evidence. Look for swollen and stiff sections of wire in the suspect circuits. - Wiring which has been pinched, cut, or its insulation rubbed through may cause an intermittent open or short as the bare area touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle. - Wiring that comes in contact with hot or exhaust components - Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required, in order to verify the customer concern. - Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. - Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis and Vehicle Data Recorder operation. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any inline connectors before replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation. Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination, usually in the underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit. Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper adapter. Always use the J 35616 when probing connectors. Other causes of terminal deformation are improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT IN BUSSED ELECTRICAL CENTERS (BEC) Page 1658 Crankshaft Position Sensor: Connector Views Engine Controls Connector End Views Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor Page 5287 Checking Aftermarket Accessories CHECKING AFTERMARKET ACCESSORIES Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits: - CAUTION: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol. - NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice. OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol. Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the cause of the problems. Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include: Power feeds connected to points other than the battery - Antenna location - Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring - Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line - Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories. Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions INDUCING INTERMITTENT FAULT CONDITIONS TOOLS REQUIRED J 25070 Heat Gun Many intermittent open or shorted circuits are affected by harness/connector movement that is caused by vibration, engine torque, bumps/rough pavement, etc. In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness if the malfunction appears to be Page 8042 3. Remove the dress cover by using a flat-blade tool to release the connector locking tabs and pulling off the dress cover. 4. Relieve the tension on the nose piece retainers by inserting J-38125-12A (12094429) into the single retainer slot on the end of the nose piece and gently prying out the locking tab. Repeat the process for both of the nose piece locking tabs on the opposite side of the nose piece. Page 7023 View of connector in released position. 4. Disconnect the connector from the component. 5. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Release the rear lower half of the wiredress cover. Page 2613 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry one side of the nose piece up to the pre-stage position. When the nose piece is in the pre-staged position, the nose piece will be raised above the connector body the length of the step in the nose piece. 7. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry the other side of the piece to the pre-stage position. If the nose piece is higher than the first step in the nose piece, gently push down on the nose piece until it meets with resistance from the connector body, you should feel the nose piece click into position. Page 2849 Alignment: Description and Operation Toe Description Toe Description Toe Description Toe is a measurement of how much the front and/or rear wheels are turned in or out from a straight-ahead position. When the wheels are turned in, toe is positive (+). When the wheels are turned out, toe is negative (-). The actual amount of toe is normally only a fraction of a degree. The purpose of toe is to ensure that the wheels roll parallel. Toe also offsets the small deflections of the wheel support system that occur when the vehicle is rolling forward. In other words, with the vehicle standing still and the wheels set with toe-in, the wheels tend to roll parallel on the road when the vehicle is moving. Improper toe adjustment will cause premature tire wear and cause steering instability. Service and Repair Rocker Arm Assembly: Service and Repair Valve Rocker Arm and Push Rod Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Remove the valve rocker arm cover. Refer to Valve Rocker Arm Cover Replacement - Left Side or to Valve Rocker Arm Cover Replacement Right Side. Important: Place the valve rocker arms, pushrods, and pivot support, in a rack so that the can be installed in the same location from which they were removed. 2. Remove the valve rocker arm bolts. 3. Remove the valve rocker arms. 4. Remove the valve rocker arm pivot support. 5. Remove the pushrods. 6. Clean and inspect the valve rocker arms and pushrods. Refer to Valve Rocker Arm and Push Rods Cleaning and Inspection. Installation Procedure Page 6730 6. Gently pry the plastic terminal retainer down and carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (16-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, pull the two connector halves apart. Page 5373 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link). - The wire insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. 5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold them between thumb and forefinger. 7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place. - Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction. - Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip. 8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool closes.Ensure that no strands of wire are cut. 10. Crimp the splice on each end (2). Page 5516 Page 2257 8. Insert the J 38125-213 into the small terminal release hole on the nose piece and gently pull on the back of the wire. 9. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Repairing Connector Terminals REPAIRING CONNECTOR TERMINALS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following: Push to Seat terminals - Pull to Seat terminals Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your terminal repair. The J-38125 contains further information. 1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.For cable seal terminals, remove the seal. 2. Apply the correct cable seal per gage size of the wire, if used.Slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation removal. 3. Remove the insulation. 4. For sealed terminals only, align the seal with the end of the cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal.For sealed terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal. 6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.For sealed terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable. 8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals excepting Micro-Pack 100.64 size. Soldering Micro-Pack 100 World terminals may damage the terminal. Sumitomo Connectors SUMITOMO CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Service and Repair Push Rod: Service and Repair Valve Rocker Arm and Push Rod Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Remove the valve rocker arm cover. Refer to Valve Rocker Arm Cover Replacement - Left Side or to Valve Rocker Arm Cover Replacement Right Side. Important: Place the valve rocker arms, pushrods, and pivot support, in a rack so that the can be installed in the same location from which they were removed. 2. Remove the valve rocker arm bolts. 3. Remove the valve rocker arms. 4. Remove the valve rocker arm pivot support. 5. Remove the pushrods. 6. Clean and inspect the valve rocker arms and pushrods. Refer to Valve Rocker Arm and Push Rods Cleaning and Inspection. Installation Procedure Page 7003 Page 1904 4. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the rear of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. 5. Once the locking tabs are unlocked, slide the inner connector out of the rear of the connector housing. Locations Oxygen Sensor: Locations Engine Controls Component Views Below Rear of the Engine 1 - Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Bank 2 Sensor 2 2 - Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Bank 2 Sensor 1 3 - Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Bank 1 Sensor 2 4 - Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Bank 1 Sensor 1 Page 8343 7. Wrap electrical tape around the connection as shown. 8. Route the engine coolant heater cord and extension cord behind the alternator and adjacent to the engine coolant crossover pipe as shown. 9. Continue to route the extension cord to the exit location desired by the customer as shown. 10. Review the routing of the coolant heater cord and extension cord to verify that it does not touch any sharp edges that could damage it. 11. Secure the engine coolant heater cord and the extension cord with tie straps as needed. 12. Resecure any of the original clips that retained the engine coolant heater cord to the vehicle that were released to provide length. Part Information The extension cord may be obtained at any of the following outlets: - Lowes* - Home Depot* - Canada: Acklands-Grainger* (www.acklandsgrainger.com), Catalogue Part Number: CWRSJTOW3C14-10 USA: Cords should bear the UL symbol. Canada: Cords should bear the ULc symbol or CSA approval. *We believe these sources and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume any responsibility for the products or material from these firms or for any such items that may be available from other sources. Page 5978 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) and slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. Page 924 Caution When performing service on or near the SIR components or the SIR wiring, the SIR system must be disabled. Failure to observe the correct procedure could cause deployment of the SIR components. Serious injury can occur. Failure to observe the correct procedure could also result in unnecessary SIR system repairs. 1. Perform the Diagnostic System Check-Vehicle. 2. Identify the DTC that is set AND review the DTC Descriptor in the corresponding diagnostic procedure. Refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List-Vehicle in SI. 3. Using the information from the DTC Descriptor, determine the location of the affected electrical connector. Refer to SIR Identification Views and the Master Electrical Component List in SI. 4. Turn OFF the ignition and disable the supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system. Refer to SIR Disabling and Enabling in SI. 5. BEFORE removing, INSPECT the CPA retainer at the electrical connector. Note The connector and connector position assurance (CPA) may seat independent of each other. Both the connector and CPA should seat with an audible and/or tactile click. The CPA isolates the shorting-bars within the connector allowing the deployment circuit to operate properly. ‹› If the CPA retainer is loose, damaged, or will not seat in the connector, replace it with a new one. Reinstall the CPA correctly by first pushing the connector body in completely, and then pushing the CPA retainer in completely. ‹› If the CPA retainer is not loose or damaged and is properly seated, proceed to Step 6. 6. Remove the CPA retainer and disconnect the electrical connector. Inspect the terminals for the following conditions: - Corrosion - Contamination - Terminal tension - Damage Important The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made with a special plating. This plating provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. Use the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit for repairing SIR/SRS terminals and connectors. DO NOT substitute any other terminals for those in the repair kit. ‹› If the terminals are damaged, corrosion is observed, or have poor tension, repair or replace as necessary. Apply dielectric grease, GM P/N 12345579 (in Canada, use P/N 10953481) on the connector pins and terminals when reassembling. Refer to SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs in SI. Note The connector and connector position assurance (CPA) may seat independent of each other. Both the connector and CPA should seat with an audible and/or tactile click. The CPA isolates the shorting-bars within the connector allowing the deployment circuit to operate properly. 7. Connect the electrical connector, and install the CPA retainer. 8. Enable the supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system. Refer to SIR Disabling and Enabling in SI. 9. Clear the DTC with a scan tool. 10. Verify that the DTC does not reset by performing the Diagnostic Repair Verification in SI. ‹› If any DTC resets, then refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle in SI. Parts Information Note If the CPA retainer P/N 54590003 (Orange CPA) cannot be located in the J-38125 SIR/SRS terminal repair kit, contact Kent Moore Tools and order P/N 54590003-PKG to obtain a package of 5. Page 4854 Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size. REPAIRING A FUSIBLE LINK IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient overload protection. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. Flat Wire Repairs FLAT WIRE REPAIRS NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced. GMLAN Wiring Repairs GMLAN WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The GM Local Area Network (GMLAN) System requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working on GMLAN connectors and terminals. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items in order to repair the GMLAN wiring: Dura Seal splice sleeves - A wire stripping tool - J 38125-8 Crimping Tool (GM P/N 12085115) - J 38125-5 Ultra Torch Special Tool (GM P/N 12085116) The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. - A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors GMLAN REPAIRS IMPORTANT: When making a repair to any GMLAN network, the original wire length after the repair must be the same length as before the repair. If the network is a twisted pair, the twist must be maintained after the repair is completed. GMLAN has 2 types of networks, low speed and high speed. Low speed GMLAN has a single wire and works at slow speeds. High speed GMLAN has 2 wires in a twisted pair and works at higher speeds. For more information on GMLAN, refer to Data Link Communications Description and Operation. GMLAN CONNECTOR TERMINAL REPAIR IMPORTANT: A service terminal can be used to replace damaged connector terminals for both high speed and low speed GMLAN systems. When making a connector terminal repair on a GMLAN high speed system with twisted pair wires, do not untwist the wires more than necessary to make the repair. The terminals in the GMLAN system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are available in the J-38125. If the individual terminals are damaged on any GMLAN connection, use the appropriate connector repair procedure in order to repair the terminal. GMLAN WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 8838 3. Use a small flat-bladed tool to gently pry off the dress cover by inserting the tool under the cover opposite the harness side and prying up. 4. Remove the cover. 5. Using a small flat-bladed tool, push on the side of the nose piece retainer while pushing the nose piece forward with your thumb. This will release the terminal position assurance (TPA). 6. Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) into the corresponding terminal release cavity. The release cavities are the 2 center rows of cavities on one half of the connector. Page 1879 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) and slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. Page 525 5. Once the nose piece retainers are relaxed, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should raise slightly. 6. On the opposite side of the nose piece, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should release completely. If the nose piece does not come off, repeat the procedure on the opposite side. Page 7375 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully raise the TPA on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA cannot be removed from the connector while there are terminals present in the connector body. View of the TPA when removed from the connector body. 4. Use the J 38125-12A tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the left side of the terminal release cavity as shown in the graphic. Use the tool to move the terminal release to the right with a gentle prying motion. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 5646 Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Install the ECT sensor. Tighten the sensor to 20 N.m (15 lb ft). 3. Connect the ECT sensor electrical connector (1). 4. Refill the engine coolant. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System (LL8) Draining and Filling Cooling System (LH6, LS2). Page 5997 5. Once the nose piece retainers are relaxed, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should raise slightly. 6. On the opposite side of the nose piece, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should release completely. If the nose piece does not come off, repeat the procedure on the opposite side. Page 5742 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Start in the middle and gradually move the heat barrel to the open ends of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Heated Oxygen Sensor Wiring Repairs HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being obstructed. If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. - Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks, etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire. - Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance. - To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector. Page 5891 Page 5958 11. Insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) into the 2 triangular cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 12. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE 1. Prior to installation the terminal must be aligned so the (1) coding lugs align with the (2) coding grooves on the connector. 2. Once the terminal is aligned, slide the terminal into the cavity until the retainer has engaged in the cavity of the connector. 3. Slide the TPA in the connector body and seat it using a small flat bladed tool. The TPA is seated when it is flush with the contact housing. 4. Secure the wires to the connector body using a tie wrap and replace the dress cover and grommet. Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) BOSCH CONNECTORS (2.8 JPT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Pull out the slider on the connector position assurance (CPA) until it is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 2037 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert a small flat-blade tool in the slot below the front loaded terminal position assurance (TPA) and pry up. 3. Remove the TPA by pulling it out of the connector. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-553 (GM P/N 15315247) on a slight upward angle into the cavity below the terminal to be removed. Ensure that the pointed on the end of the tool is facing the bottom of the terminal and it stays in contact with the terminal until it stops on the plastic terminal retainer. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 5168 5. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove TPA from the connector. 6. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Engine/Transmission - Aftermarket Calibrations Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine/Transmission - Aftermarket Calibrations INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 09-06-04-026C Date: August 13, 2010 Subject: Identifying Non-GM (Aftermarket) Engine and Transmission Calibrations for V8 Gas Engines Using Tech 2(R) or Global Diagnostic System (GDS) Models: 2006-2011 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Excluding Saab 9-7X) 2006-2009 HUMMER H2 2006-2010 HUMMER H3 Equipped with V8 Gas Powered Engines Only Attention: This bulletin applies to V8 gas powered engines ONLY. For Duramax(TM) diesel powered engines, refer to the latest version of Corporate Bulletin Number 08-06-04-006G. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2011 model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 09-06-04-026A (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). General Motors is identifying an increasing number of engine, transmission and catalytic converter part failures that are the result of non-GM (aftermarket) engine and transmission control calibrations being used. When alteration to the GM-released engine or transmission control calibrations occurs, it subjects powertrain and driveline components (engine , transmission, transfer case, driveshaft and rear axle) to stresses that were not tested by General Motors. It is because of these unknown stresses, and the potential to alter reliability, durability and emissions performance, that GM has adopted a policy that prevents any UNAUTHORIZED dealer warranty claim submissions to any remaining warranty coverage, to the powertrain and driveline components whenever the presence of a non-GM (aftermarket) calibration is confirmed - even if the non-GM control module calibration is subsequently removed. Warranty coverage is based on the equipment and calibrations that were released on the vehicle at time of sale, or subsequently updated by GM. That's because GM testing and validation matches the calibration to a host of criteria that is essential to assure reliability, durability and emissions performance over the life of the warranty coverage and beyond. Stresses resulting from calibrations different from those tested and released by GM can damage or weaken components, leading to poor performance and or shortened life. Additionally, non-GM (aftermarket) issued engine control modifications often do not meet the same emissions performance standards as GM issued calibrations. Depending on state statutes, individuals who install engine control module calibrations that put the vehicle outside the parameters of emissions certification standards may be subject to fines and/or penalties. This bulletin outlines a procedure to identify the presence of non-GM (aftermarket) calibrations. GM recommends performing this check whenever a hard part failure is seen on internal engine or transmission components, or before an engine assembly or transmission assembly is being replaced under warranty. It is also recommended that the engine calibration verification procedure be performed whenever diagnostics indicate that catalytic converter replacement is indicated. The PQC has a process to confirm the ECM/PCM calibration is GM issued. The PQC will require a picture of the engine calibration verification screen, as outlined in this bulletin, before authorizing any V8 gas powered engine replacement. If a non-GM calibration is found and verification has taken place through GM, the remaining powertrain and driveline warranty will be blocked and notated in GMVIS and the dealership will be notified. This block prevents any UNAUTHORIZED warranty claim submission. 1. Connect the Tech 2(R) to the vehicle. 2. Go to: Diagnostics and build the vehicle. 3. Select: Powertrain. 4. Select: Engine. 5. *Select: Engine Control Module or PCM. 6. *Select: Module ID Information or I/M Information System if the Module ID Information selection is not available. 7. *If "I/M information System" was selected, it may be necessary to select "Vehicle Information" in order to display the calibration information. ‹› If the CVN information is displayed as "N/A", it will be necessary to contact the TCSC to obtain the CVN information. Page 6818 For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 7516 REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. The release tab is located on the top of the wiredress cover. View of connector in released position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Page 7005 Page 8147 - JST connectors have JST in small letters on their connectors, similar to that above. The location of the logo will vary with the connector size and style. - Kostel has an "LK" with a circle around it. These connector are usually used as a transmissions connection and are currently use on some Cadillac vehicles. Page 6462 4. Slide the dress cover forward and off of the connector. 5. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front and rear of the connector. Page 1966 vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide variety of actions, including: - Wiggling the harness - Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting - Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector - Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation - Relocating a harness or wires All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. Another option is, with the component commanded ON and OFF by the scan tool, move related connectors and wiring and observe the component operation. With the engine running, move related connectors and wiring while monitoring engine operation. If harness or connector movement affects the data displayed, component/system operation, or engine operation, inspect and repair the harness/connections as necessary. You may need to load the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these cases you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide good results as well. There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions, along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the circuit to these kinds of conditions. SALT WATER SPRAY Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture. Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5 percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously. HIGH TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070. Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault condition. The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis. This option does not allow for the same control, however. LOW TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect. If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to -18°C (0°F) from one end and +71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized cooling needs. Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or components in an effort to duplicate the concern. DUPLICATING FAILURE CONDITIONS - If none of the previous tests are successful, attempt to duplicate and/or capture the failure conditions. Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, where applicable, contains the conditions that were present when the DTC set. 1. Review and record Freeze Frame/Failure Records data. 2. Clear the DTCs using the scan tool. 3. Turn the key to OFF and wait 15 seconds. 4. Operate the vehicle under the same conditions that were noted in Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, as closely as possible. The vehicle must also be operating within the Conditions for Running the DTC. Refer to Conditions for Running the DTC in the supporting text if a DTC is being diagnosed. 5. Monitor DTC Status for the DTC being tested. The scan tool will indicate Ran, when the enabling conditions have been satisfied long enough for the DTC to run. The scan tool will also indicate whether the DTC passed or failed. - An alternate method is to drive the vehicle with the DMM connected to a suspected circuit. An abnormal reading on the DMM when the concern occurs, may help you locate the concern. Measuring Frequency Page 7632 View of a typical Micro 64 connector. Depress the lock and pull the lever over and past the lock. Page 1358 2. Locate the two indents of the terminal position assurance (TPA) located on the bottom of the connector body. Page 1061 Power Seat Switch: Diagrams Seat Adjuster Switch Seat Adjuster Switch - Driver (With RPO Code AR9) Page 8602 US English/Metric Conversion US English/Metric Conversion Radiator Inlet Hose Replacement Radiator Hose: Service and Repair Radiator Inlet Hose Replacement Radiator Inlet Hose Replacement (LH6, LS2) Tools Required J 38185 Hose Clamp Pliers Removal Procedure 1. Drain the cooling system. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System (LL8) Draining and Filling Cooling System (LH6, LS2). 2. Remove the air intake resonator. Refer to Air Cleaner Resonator Outlet Duct Replacement for the 5.3L engine or Air Cleaner Resonator Outlet Duct Replacement for the 6.0L engine. 3. Using J 38185 reposition the radiator inlet hose clamp (1) from the engine. 4. Remove the outlet hose from the engine. 5. Using J 38185 reposition the radiator inlet hose clamp (2) from the radiator. 6. Remove the radiator outlet hose from the radiator. Installation Procedure Locations Ride Height Sensor: Locations Air Suspension Component Views Rear Frame and Underbody Rear Frame and Underbody - Short Wheelbase (SWB) 1 - Air Suspension Sensor - LR 2 - Air Suspension Sensor - RR 3 - Air Suspension Compressor Assembly 4 - Air Suspension Inflator Switch 5 - Frame Page 7319 Page 815 Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Page 8191 5. While pushing the terminal forward, insert the J 38125-24 in the release cavity above the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (43-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Page 136 5. Position the right second row seat to a passenger position. Page 2246 4. Use a small flat-blade tool to slide the terminal position assurance (TPA) up one notch on both ends of the connector. The TPA is located underneath the wire dress cover. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 8656 If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200 DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J 39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected. IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J 39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and maximum (MAX) values measured. 1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of a suspected circuit to the other. 2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J 39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep). IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value in order to record the full change. 5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling the connections or the wiring, test driving, or performing other operations. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions. 6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9. Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist. Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections TESTING FOR INTERMITTENT CONDITIONS AND POOR CONNECTIONS TOOLS REQUIRED - J 35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit - J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit When the condition is not currently present, but is indicated in DTC history, the cause may be intermittent. An intermittent may also be the cause when there is a customer complaint, but the symptom cannot be duplicated. Refer to the Symptom Table of the system that is suspect of causing the condition before trying to locate an intermittent condition. Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the following items: Wiring broken inside the insulation - Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector - Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself, and corrosion in the wire to terminal contact area, etc. - Pierced or damaged insulation can allow moisture to enter the wiring causing corrosion. The conductor can corrode inside the insulation, with little visible evidence. Look for swollen and stiff sections of wire in the suspect circuits. - Wiring which has been pinched, cut, or its insulation rubbed through may cause an intermittent open or short as the bare area touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle. - Wiring that comes in contact with hot or exhaust components - Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required, in order to verify the customer concern. - Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. - Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis and Vehicle Data Recorder operation. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any inline connectors before replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation. Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination, usually in the underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit. Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper adapter. Always use the J 35616 when probing connectors. Other causes of terminal deformation are improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT IN BUSSED ELECTRICAL CENTERS (BEC) Page 6733 breakers are used. CIRCUIT BREAKER This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high current is removed. POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) CIRCUIT BREAKER This type greatly increases its resistance when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker will re-close within a second or 2. Circuit Protection - Fuses CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSES The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and examine the element in the fuse for an open (2). If not broken (1), also check for continuity using a DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one of equal current rating. Circuit Protection - Fusible Links CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSIBLE LINKS TPMS System - Service And Re-Learning Sensor IDs Tire Pressure Module: Technical Service Bulletins TPMS System - Service And Re-Learning Sensor IDs INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 10-03-16-001 Date: July 19, 2010 Subject: TPMS System Service and Re-Learning Sensor IDs Models: 2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2 2009 and Prior HUMMER H3 2010 and Prior Saturn Models 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X with Wheel-Mounted Tire Pressure Sensors In the event that the spare tire, which is normally not equipped with a tire pressure monitor (TPM) sensor, is installed in place of one of the road tires and the vehicle is driven above 40 km/h (25 mph) for 20 minutes or more, the TPM indicator icon on the instrument panel cluster (IPC) will flash for approximately one minute and then remain on steady each time the ignition is turned ON, indicating a diagnostic trouble code (DTC) has been set. The driver information center (DIC), if equipped, will also display a SERVICE TIRE MONITOR type message. When the road tire is repaired and reinstalled in the original location, the TPM indicator icon illumination and DIC message may remain displayed until the DTC is cleared. To ensure that the TPM indicator and the DIC message are cleared after service, it is necessary to clear any TPM DTCs using a scan tool. If a scan tool is unavailable, performing the TPM relearn procedure using a TPM diagnostic tool will provide the same results. It is advised to perform the relearn procedure away from other vehicles to prevent picking up a stray sensor signal. If one or more of the TPM sensors are missing or damaged and have been replaced, then the relearn procedure must be performed. Disclaimer Page 3384 The first connector design of the Micro-Pack 100W (1) has a white connector interface that holds the terminals. The second design of the Micro-Pack 100W (2) has a gray interface to hold the terminals. Also, the first design has terminal cavities that are further apart (3 mm centerline) and offset from the other row of terminal cavities in the connector. The second design has terminals cavities that are closer together (2.54 mm centerline) and aligned vertically. One other way to identify the second design is the thin strip of material that runs along the outside of the cavities. IMPORTANT: There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W terminals which are very similar. Ensure that you have the correct terminal before crimping the new terminal to the wire. The first design connector uses the longer terminal (1) that has a raised area in front of the recess in the terminal. The second design connector uses the shorter terminal without the raised area. Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro-Pack 100W connectors. Some Micro-Pack 100W connector disassembly procedures will vary. Use this procedure as a guide. 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. HVAC - Automatic Control Module HVAC: Service and Repair HVAC - Automatic Auxiliary Heater and Air Conditioning Control Module Replacement Auxiliary Heater and Air Conditioning Control Module Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Using a flat bladed tool, carefully pry out on the top of the HVAC control-auxiliary. 2. Remove the HVAC control-auxiliary from the center console/seat. 3. Disconnect the electrical connector. 4. Remove the HVAC control-auxiliary. Installation Procedure 1. Connect the HVAC control-auxiliary electrical connector. 2. Install the HVAC control-auxiliary in the console bottom first. 3. Push in at the top of the HVAC control-auxiliary in order to engage the HVAC control-auxiliary in the console/seat. Blower Motor Control Processor Replacement Page 6056 Page 8515 Refer to the following table as a guide in selecting the correct test adapter for front probing connectors: Backprobe IMPORTANT: Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures. - Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector. - Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large of a test probe. - After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected, test for proper terminal contact. Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the connector. Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure SCAN TOOL SNAPSHOT PROCEDURE Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used Page 3362 3. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. View showing depressing of the lever lock release tab. Page 2640 11. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 12. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 13. Center the high temperature SCT1 shrink tube over the DuraSeal splice sleeve. 14. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the high temperature heat shrink tubing. 15. Gradually move the heat from the center to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 16. Replace any reflective tape and clips that may have been remove during the repair. Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation REPAIRING DAMAGED WIRE INSULATION Wire Size Conversion Page 8972 Open the harness by removing any tape. 2. Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. 3. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 4. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent american wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 5. Slide a section of high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing down the length of wire to be spliced. Ensure that the shrink tubing will not interfere with the splice procedure. 6. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 7. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. 8. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 9. Insert the wire into the DuraSeal splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 10. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Page 5531 It is very important to use the correct test adapter when testing for proper terminal contact of fuses and relays in a bussed electrical center (BEC). Use J-35616-35 to test for proper terminal contact. Failure to use J-35616-35 can result in improper diagnosis of the BEC. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Separate the connector halves. 2. Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body. 3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J-38125 , test that the retention force is significantly different between a good terminal and a suspect terminal. Replace the female terminal in question. FLAT WIRE (DOCK AND LOCK) CONNECTORS There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock) connectors on the harness side or the component side. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Remove the component in question. 2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side of the connector as oil from your skin may be a source of contamination as well. 3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other imperfections that could cause poor terminal contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are uniform and free of damage or deformation. 4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the on the flat wire harness connector in order to test the circuit in question. CONTROL MODULE/COMPONENT VOLTAGE AND GROUNDS Poor voltage or ground connections can cause widely varying symptoms. Test all control module voltage supply circuits. Many vehicles have multiple circuits supplying voltage to a control module. Other components in the system may have separate voltage supply circuits that may also need to be tested. Inspect connections at the module/component connectors, fuses, and any intermediate connections between the voltage source and the module/component. A test lamp or a DMM may indicate that voltage is present, but neither tests the ability of the circuit to carry sufficient current. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Power Distribution Schematics. - Test all control module ground and system ground circuits. The control module may have multiple ground circuits. Other components in the system may have separate grounds that may also need to be tested. Inspect grounds for clean and tight connections at the grounding point. Inspect the connections at the component and in splice packs, where applicable. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Ground Distribution Schematics. TEMPERATURE SENSITIVITY - An intermittent condition may occur when a component/connection reaches normal operating temperature. The condition may occur only when the component/connection is cold, or only when the component/connection is hot. - Freeze Frame, Failure Records, Snapshot, or Vehicle Data Recorder data may help with this type of intermittent condition, where applicable. - If the intermittent is related to heat, review the data for a relationship with the following: High ambient temperatures - Underhood/engine generated heat - Circuit generated heat due to a poor connection, or high electrical load - Higher than normal load conditions, towing, etc. - If the intermittent is related to cold, review the data for the following: Low ambient temperatures-In extremely low temperatures, ice may form in a connection or component. Inspect for water intrusion. - The condition only occurs on a cold start. - The condition goes away when the vehicle warms up. - Information from the customer may help to determine if the trouble follows a pattern that is temperature related. - If temperature is suspected of causing an intermittent fault condition, attempt to duplicate the condition. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required. ELECTROMAGNETIC INTERFERENCE (EMI) AND ELECTRICAL NOISE Some electrical components/circuits are sensitive to electromagnetic interference (EMI) or other types of electrical noise. Inspect for the following conditions: A misrouted harness that is too close to high voltage/high current devices such as secondary ignition components, motors, generator etc-These components may induce electrical noise on a circuit that could interfere with normal circuit operation. - Electrical system interference caused by a malfunctioning relay, or a control module driven solenoid or switch-These conditions can cause a sharp electrical surge. Normally, the condition will occur when the malfunctioning component is operating. - Improper installation of non-factory or aftermarket add on accessories such as lights, 2-way radios, amplifiers, electric motors, remote starters, alarm systems, cell phones, etc-These accessories may lead to interference while in use, but do not fail when the accessories are not in use. - Test for an open diode across the A/C compressor clutch and for other open diodes. Some relays may contain a clamping diode. - The generator may be allowing AC noise into the electrical system. INCORRECT CONTROL MODULE - There are only a few situations where reprogramming a control module is appropriate: A new service control module is installed. Page 1947 1. Connect the HO2S electrical connector (2). 2. Install the CPA retainer. Important: A special anti-seize compound is used on the HO2S threads. The compound consists of liquid graphite and glass beads. The graphite tends to burn away, but the glass beads remain, making the sensor easier to remove. New, or service replacement sensors already have the compound applied to the threads. If the sensor is removed from an exhaust component and if for any reason the sensor is to be reinstalled, the threads must have anti-seize compound applied before the reinstallation. 3. If reinstalling the old sensor, coat the threads with anti-seize compound GM P/N 12377953, or equivalent. Notice: Refer to Component Fastener Tightening Notice. Important: If the HO2S sensor is connected to the main wiring harness during installation. Rotate the HO2S sensor several turns counterclockwise before threading the HO2S sensor into the catalytic converter. This action of initially reverse winding of the pigtail wires will prevent a condition where the HO2S sensor pigtail wires become severely twisted or binding once the HO2S sensor is installed into the catalytic converter. 4. Install the HO2S (2). Tighten the sensor to 42 N.m (31 lb ft). 5. Lower the vehicle. Page 5698 7. Apply pressure and gently rock the cover until one locking leg is unseated. 8. Continue to apply pressure and rock the cover until the second locking leg is unseated. Repeat procedure for the other side of the dress cover and remove the cover. 9. Use J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) to gently lift the terminal retaining tab while gently pulling the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 10. If the terminal is severely bent or damaged, it may be possible on some connectors to push the wire out of the front of the connector instead of Page 7377 View of typical connector. View of connector in released position. 1. Locate the assist lever at the back of the connector. Move the assist lever to the rear position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the dress cover. Page 8504 Page 5360 6. Gently pry the plastic terminal retainer down and carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (16-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, pull the two connector halves apart. Page 214 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Ensure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the Terminal Removal Procedure. Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PULL TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL If the terminal is visibly damaged or is suspected of having a faulty connection, the terminal should be replaced. Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors: 1. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) device and/or the secondary lock. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component or separate the connectors for in-line connectors. 3. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device. 4. Insert the proper pick or removal tool into the front of the connector body. 5. IMPORTANT: On connectors with more than one terminal the service loop may not be large enough to remove the terminal and crimp on a new one. If the terminal wire does not have a large enough service loop for removal, cut the wire 5 cm (2 in) behind the connector before removal. Grasp the wire at the back of the connector body and gently push the terminal out the front of the connector body. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. If the wire needed to be cut in order to remove the terminal, gently push a small length of the same size wire through the back of the connector cavity until there is enough wire exposed in order to crimp on a new terminal. If the wire was not cut, cut the existing wire as close to the old terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 4. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. TERMINAL INSTALLATION 1. Align the terminal and pull the wire from the back of the connector in order to seat the terminal. 2. If necessary, cut the new wire to proper length and splice with existing circuit. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. 3. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply dielectric grease to the connector. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PUSH TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 4629 REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. The release tab is located on the top of the wiredress cover. View of connector in released position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Page 7097 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link). - The wire insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. 5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold them between thumb and forefinger. 7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place. - Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction. - Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip. 8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool closes.Ensure that no strands of wire are cut. 10. Crimp the splice on each end (2). Page 5937 Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Page 2234 The first connector design of the Micro-Pack 100W (1) has a white connector interface that holds the terminals. The second design of the Micro-Pack 100W (2) has a gray interface to hold the terminals. Also, the first design has terminal cavities that are further apart (3 mm centerline) and offset from the other row of terminal cavities in the connector. The second design has terminals cavities that are closer together (2.54 mm centerline) and aligned vertically. One other way to identify the second design is the thin strip of material that runs along the outside of the cavities. IMPORTANT: There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W terminals which are very similar. Ensure that you have the correct terminal before crimping the new terminal to the wire. The first design connector uses the longer terminal (1) that has a raised area in front of the recess in the terminal. The second design connector uses the shorter terminal without the raised area. Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro-Pack 100W connectors. Some Micro-Pack 100W connector disassembly procedures will vary. Use this procedure as a guide. 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. Capacity Specifications Refrigerant Oil: Capacity Specifications Refrigerant System Capacities Page 6251 2. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 4501 - Most Molex connectors will have the Molex logo on the dresscover of the connector. In some cases the connectors may have MX followed by another letter. The third letter indicates where the connector was made. A connector with MXD is a Molex connector made in Detroit. Sumitomo has a unique symbol on their connector and possibly a part number. The symbol is similar to that of a diamond lying on its side, similar to that shown. The logo could appear anywhere but the most common place is at the wire side of the housing. Tyco/AMP has many different and unique connector designs. Some may or may not have identifiable marks on them. Page 1996 4. Once the front 2 locks are unlocked, lift the front of the dress cover and pull it forward. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the small slot on the TPA and pushing down until the TPA releases. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to angle or rock the J 38125-21 tool when inserting it into the connector or the tool may break. Insert the J 38125-21 (GM P/N 15381651-2) tool into the round canal between the terminals cavities at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to repair Micro 64 connector terminals. The Micro 64 connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-64 (M jaw) was developed to crimp Micro 64 terminals. The J 38125-64 crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. The J 38125-64 crimping tool is also designed to crimp both the wire and the insulation at the same time. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro 64 terminals. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. 1. Cut the wire as close to the damaged terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. Page 6666 Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested: - Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. - Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a component or to other harnesses. - If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A TEST LAMP TOOLS REQUIRED J 35616-200 Test Light - Probe Kit NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminate even though voltage is present. The J 35616-200 is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair of leads. To properly operate this tool use the following procedures. When testing for voltage: 1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested. When testing for ground: 1. Attach one lead to battery positive voltage. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where ground should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is ground at the point being tested. Using Connector Test Adapters USING CONNECTOR TEST ADAPTERS NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Using Fused Jumper Wires USING FUSED JUMPER WIRES TOOLS REQUIRED J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged. The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested. AFL/ECP Connectors AFL/EPC CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 2047 11. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 12. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 13. Center the high temperature SCT1 shrink tube over the DuraSeal splice sleeve. 14. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the high temperature heat shrink tubing. 15. Gradually move the heat from the center to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 16. Replace any reflective tape and clips that may have been remove during the repair. Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation REPAIRING DAMAGED WIRE INSULATION Wire Size Conversion Page 6930 8. Insert the J 38125-213 into the small terminal release hole on the nose piece and gently pull on the back of the wire. 9. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Repairing Connector Terminals REPAIRING CONNECTOR TERMINALS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following: Push to Seat terminals - Pull to Seat terminals Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your terminal repair. The J-38125 contains further information. 1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.For cable seal terminals, remove the seal. 2. Apply the correct cable seal per gage size of the wire, if used.Slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation removal. 3. Remove the insulation. 4. For sealed terminals only, align the seal with the end of the cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal.For sealed terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal. 6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.For sealed terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable. 8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals excepting Micro-Pack 100.64 size. Soldering Micro-Pack 100 World terminals may damage the terminal. Sumitomo Connectors SUMITOMO CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 1930 US English/Metric Conversion US English/Metric Conversion Page 7810 5. Once the nose piece retainers are relaxed, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should raise slightly. 6. On the opposite side of the nose piece, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should release completely. If the nose piece does not come off, repeat the procedure on the opposite side. Mechanical Specifications Engine Oil: Mechanical Specifications Lubrication System Oil Capacity - with Filter ....................................................................................................................... ............................................ 5.68 liters 6.0 quarts Oil Capacity - without Filter .............................................................................................................................................................. 5.20 liters 5.5 quarts Locations Discharge Air Temperature Sensor / Switch: Locations HVAC Component Views Instrument Panel Carrier - Center Section 1 - Air Temperature Sensor - Lower Left Instrument Panel Carrier - Air Duct 1 - Air Temperature Sensor - Upper Left 2 - Air Temperature Sensor - Upper Right Instrument Panel Carrier - Right Side Page 3755 The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors. 1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position. 4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool J 38125-10A (GM P/N 12014012-1) into the front (mating end) of the connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal through the back of the connector (2). IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector. 6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. 7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily. 10. Perform system check. Delphi Connectors (12 Way) DELPHI CONNECTORS (12-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. Page 2470 4. Use a small flat-blade tool to slide the terminal position assurance (TPA) up one notch on both ends of the connector. The TPA is located underneath the wire dress cover. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 2258 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 1421 All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system. Locations Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Locations Immobilizer Component Views Behind Left Headlamp 1 - Headlamp Leveling Actuator - Left (TR6) 2 - Hood Ajar Switch (UA2) Page 7032 5. Insert the J 38125-557 (GM P/N 12122378) into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 6. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Connector Position Assurance Locks CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of the connector. CPAs are used in various connectors throughout the vehicle. CPAs are also used in all SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals, of the connector. Connector Repairs CONNECTOR REPAIRS Page 2502 Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size. REPAIRING A FUSIBLE LINK IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient overload protection. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. Flat Wire Repairs FLAT WIRE REPAIRS NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced. GMLAN Wiring Repairs GMLAN WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The GM Local Area Network (GMLAN) System requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working on GMLAN connectors and terminals. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items in order to repair the GMLAN wiring: Dura Seal splice sleeves - A wire stripping tool - J 38125-8 Crimping Tool (GM P/N 12085115) - J 38125-5 Ultra Torch Special Tool (GM P/N 12085116) The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. - A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors GMLAN REPAIRS IMPORTANT: When making a repair to any GMLAN network, the original wire length after the repair must be the same length as before the repair. If the network is a twisted pair, the twist must be maintained after the repair is completed. GMLAN has 2 types of networks, low speed and high speed. Low speed GMLAN has a single wire and works at slow speeds. High speed GMLAN has 2 wires in a twisted pair and works at higher speeds. For more information on GMLAN, refer to Data Link Communications Description and Operation. GMLAN CONNECTOR TERMINAL REPAIR IMPORTANT: A service terminal can be used to replace damaged connector terminals for both high speed and low speed GMLAN systems. When making a connector terminal repair on a GMLAN high speed system with twisted pair wires, do not untwist the wires more than necessary to make the repair. The terminals in the GMLAN system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are available in the J-38125. If the individual terminals are damaged on any GMLAN connection, use the appropriate connector repair procedure in order to repair the terminal. GMLAN WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 3990 Drive Belt: Description and Operation Drive Belt System Description The drive belt system consists of the following components: ^ The drive belt ^ The drive belt tensioner ^ The drive belt idler pulley ^ The crankshaft balancer pulley ^ The accessory drive component mounting brackets ^ The accessory drive components The power steering pump, if belt driven - The generator - The A/C compressor, if equipped - The engine cooling fan, if belt driven - The water pump, if belt driven - The vacuum pump, if equipped - The air compressor, if equipped The drive belt system may use 1 belt or 2 belts. The drive belt is thin so that it can bend backwards and has several ribs to match the grooves in the pulleys. There also may be a V-belt style belt used to drive certain accessory drive components. The drive belts are made of different types of rubbers - chloroprene or EPDM - and have different layers or plies containing either fiber cloth or cords for reinforcement. Both sides of the drive belt may be used to drive the different accessory drive components. When the back side of the drive belt is used to drive a pulley, the pulley is smooth. The drive belt is pulled by the crankshaft balancer pulley across the accessory drive component pulleys. The spring loaded drive belt tensioner keeps constant tension on the drive belt to prevent the drive belt from slipping. The drive belt tensioner arm will move when loads are applied to the drive belt by the accessory drive components and the crankshaft. The drive belt system may have an idler pulley, which is used to add wrap to the adjacent pulleys. Some systems use an idler pulley in place of an accessory drive component when the vehicle is not equipped with the accessory. Page 556 5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape. Seat Belt Schematic Icons Seat Belt Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons Page 4780 IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals. Front probe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the connector. IMPORTANT: When probing female 0.64 terminals, it is important to use the correct adapter. There have been some revisions to the test adapter for 0.64 terminals. The proper adapter for 0.64 terminals is the J 35616-64B which has a gold terminal and a black wire between the base and tip. Failure to use the proper test adapter may result in damage to the terminal being tested and improper diagnosis. NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Page 5181 Depress the locks that are located on both sides of the wiredress cover and pull the lever over and past the locks. View of the connector when released from the component. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the front of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool push down on one of the locking tabs and pull the cover up until the dress cover releases. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. Page 3224 Page 4444 If a wire is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm, etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except coaxial. - Do not use the DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent American wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 7015 Refer to the following table as a guide in selecting the correct test adapter for front probing connectors: Backprobe IMPORTANT: Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures. - Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector. - Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large of a test probe. - After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected, test for proper terminal contact. Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the connector. Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure SCAN TOOL SNAPSHOT PROCEDURE Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used Page 7522 View of typical connector. View of connector in released position. 1. Locate the assist lever at the back of the connector. Move the assist lever to the rear position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the dress cover. Page 5337 View of typical connector. View of connector in released position. 1. Locate the assist lever at the back of the connector. Move the assist lever to the rear position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the dress cover. Diagram Information and Instructions Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions Electrical Symbols Page 8351 20. Extract a portion of the ECT sensor harness wiring and connector from the protective conduit. Cut off the ECT sensor harness connector and wiring. 21. Determine a routing path for the ECT sensor jumper harness wires so that they can be secured TO or WITHIN an existing protective conduit. Note This step is to set up and verify the length of wiring that is required before cutting. 22. Route the ECT sensor jumper wires and then enclose them in their own protective conduit in order to VERIFY the length that is required. 23. Cut the ECT sensor jumper wires to the appropriate length. Note Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splice or connector. 24. Splice the ECT sensor jumper wires to the ORIGINAL ECT HARNESS LOCATION using DuraSeal weatherproof splices. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves in SI. Note Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splice or connector. 25. Splice the ECT sensor jumper wires to the ECT SENSOR HARNESS CONNECTOR using DuraSeal weatherproof splices. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves in SI. 26. Connect the ECT sensor harness connector to the ECT sensor. 27. Secure the ECT sensor jumper wires that are in their own protective conduit TO or WITHIN the existing harness conduit using tie straps. Important You MUST run the engine at the specified RPM and until it reaches normal operating temperature and then allow it to idle as indicated in SI. The engine MUST then be allowed to cool down in order to top off the coolant level as needed. 28. Fill the cooling system to the proper level. Refer to Cooling System Draining and Filling in SI. 29. Pressure test the cooling system. Refer to Cooling System Leak Testing in SI. 30. Use a scan tool to clear any DTCs. Relocating the Engine Coolant Heater Cord Important For reference, the procedure and graphics that are shown are from a Chevrolet Silverado, but are similar for the other vehicles listed above. 1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Ask the customer where they would prefer the extension cord to exit from the engine compartment in order to determine the required extension cord length. 3. Obtain an extension cord with the following features: - 120 volt - 14/3 gauge - 15A capacity - Three prong - Polarized plug and receptacle - Chemical resistant - Grounded terminals - Designed for use in a cold outdoor environment - Outer jacket resistant to deterioration from moisture, abrasion and exposure to sunlight - Maximum length of 2.5-3 m (8-10 ft) 4. Release enough of the clips that retain the engine coolant heater cord to the vehicle to provide the necessary length for repositioning. 5. Apply dielectric grease to the electrical contacts of the heater cord receptacle and the extension cord plug to prevent corrosion. Use GM P/N 12345579 (in Canada, use P/N 10953481) or an equivalent. 6. Connect the heater cord receptacle to the extension cord plug and wipe OFF any excess grease. Page 6533 Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested: - Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. - Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a component or to other harnesses. - If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A TEST LAMP TOOLS REQUIRED J 35616-200 Test Light - Probe Kit NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminate even though voltage is present. The J 35616-200 is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair of leads. To properly operate this tool use the following procedures. When testing for voltage: 1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested. When testing for ground: 1. Attach one lead to battery positive voltage. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where ground should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is ground at the point being tested. Using Connector Test Adapters USING CONNECTOR TEST ADAPTERS NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Using Fused Jumper Wires USING FUSED JUMPER WIRES TOOLS REQUIRED J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged. The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested. AFL/ECP Connectors AFL/EPC CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 4908 5. Insert the J 38125-557 (GM P/N 12122378) into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 6. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Connector Position Assurance Locks CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of the connector. CPAs are used in various connectors throughout the vehicle. CPAs are also used in all SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals, of the connector. Connector Repairs CONNECTOR REPAIRS Page 7373 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. JST Connectors JST CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, remove the connector from the component. Page 1476 4. Slide the dress cover forward and off of the connector. 5. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front and rear of the connector. Page 6100 pulling it through. This will prevent damage to the internal seals of the connector. Once the terminal is pushed out of the connector, cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible and pull the wire through the connector. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE The Micro-Pack 100W connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool was developed to crimp Micro-Pack 100W terminals. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 2. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert the terminal into the crimp tool until the core wings are flush with the anvil on the crimp tool. Be sure that the wings are pointed toward the crimp tool former and release the spring locator. The locator will hold the terminal in place. Inspect the alignment of the terminal wings with the crimp tool former. If the terminal wings are wider than the crimp tool former, remove the terminal and bend the terminal wings in slightly. 5. Place stripped wire into terminal. 6. Crimp the new terminal to the wire. If a jam occurs, press the emergency release to open applicator. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire perform the following procedure in order to replace Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. Page 4473 Page 6589 4. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the rear of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. 5. Once the locking tabs are unlocked, slide the inner connector out of the rear of the connector housing. Page 6209 Connector Anatomy Connector Repairs contains a list of all connector repairs. The connector repairs are listed by the connector manufacturer and then by connector type. If the technician cannot identify the manufacturer of the connector, refer to Identifying Connectors below. Knowing the connector manufacturer will assist in finding the correct connector repair from the following list: - Connector Position Assurance Locks - Terminal Position Assurance Locks - Bosch Connectors (0.64) Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) Bosch Connectors (BSK) Bosch Connectors (ECM) - Delphi Connectors (Micro.64) Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) Delphi Connectors (12-Way) - Tyco/AMP Connectors (CM 42-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) Tyco/AMP Connectors (025 Cap) Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) - Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) - Repairing Connector Terminals IDENTIFYING CONNECTORS Knowing the connector manufacturer is helpful when trying to locating the correct connector repair procedure. There are many different connector designs used on GM vehicles and it is sometimes difficult to identify the connector manufacturer. The information in this document should help with the identification of connector manufactures. The following connector manufacturers make most of the connectors found in GM vehicles: AFL/EPC (Alcoa Fujikura Ltd./Engineered Plastics Components) - Bosch - Delphi - FCI (Framatome Connectors International) - JAE (Japan Aviation Electronics) - JST (Japan Solderless Terminals) Page 5421 3. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. View showing depressing of the lever lock release tab. Page 3405 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. 4. Remove the dress cover by using a flat bladed tool to release the dress cover locking tabs and lift up on the dress cover. 5. Cut the tie wrap that holds the wires to the connector body. Page 8550 The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors. 1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position. 4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool J 38125-10A (GM P/N 12014012-1) into the front (mating end) of the connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal through the back of the connector (2). IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector. 6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. 7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily. 10. Perform system check. Delphi Connectors (12 Way) DELPHI CONNECTORS (12-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. Page 1541 7. Wrap electrical tape around the connection as shown. 8. Route the engine coolant heater cord and extension cord behind the alternator and adjacent to the engine coolant crossover pipe as shown. 9. Continue to route the extension cord to the exit location desired by the customer as shown. 10. Review the routing of the coolant heater cord and extension cord to verify that it does not touch any sharp edges that could damage it. 11. Secure the engine coolant heater cord and the extension cord with tie straps as needed. 12. Resecure any of the original clips that retained the engine coolant heater cord to the vehicle that were released to provide length. Part Information The extension cord may be obtained at any of the following outlets: - Lowes* - Home Depot* - Canada: Acklands-Grainger* (www.acklandsgrainger.com), Catalogue Part Number: CWRSJTOW3C14-10 USA: Cords should bear the UL symbol. Canada: Cords should bear the ULc symbol or CSA approval. *We believe these sources and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume any responsibility for the products or material from these firms or for any such items that may be available from other sources. Page 2551 Page 173 All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system. Page 8517 If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200 DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J 39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected. IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J 39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and maximum (MAX) values measured. 1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of a suspected circuit to the other. 2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J 39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep). IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value in order to record the full change. 5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling the connections or the wiring, test driving, or performing other operations. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions. 6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9. Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist. Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections TESTING FOR INTERMITTENT CONDITIONS AND POOR CONNECTIONS TOOLS REQUIRED - J 35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit - J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit When the condition is not currently present, but is indicated in DTC history, the cause may be intermittent. An intermittent may also be the cause when there is a customer complaint, but the symptom cannot be duplicated. Refer to the Symptom Table of the system that is suspect of causing the condition before trying to locate an intermittent condition. Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the following items: Wiring broken inside the insulation - Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector - Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself, and corrosion in the wire to terminal contact area, etc. - Pierced or damaged insulation can allow moisture to enter the wiring causing corrosion. The conductor can corrode inside the insulation, with little visible evidence. Look for swollen and stiff sections of wire in the suspect circuits. - Wiring which has been pinched, cut, or its insulation rubbed through may cause an intermittent open or short as the bare area touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle. - Wiring that comes in contact with hot or exhaust components - Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required, in order to verify the customer concern. - Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. - Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis and Vehicle Data Recorder operation. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any inline connectors before replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation. Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination, usually in the underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit. Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper adapter. Always use the J 35616 when probing connectors. Other causes of terminal deformation are improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT IN BUSSED ELECTRICAL CENTERS (BEC) Page 2046 Open the harness by removing any tape. 2. Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. 3. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 4. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent american wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 5. Slide a section of high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing down the length of wire to be spliced. Ensure that the shrink tubing will not interfere with the splice procedure. 6. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 7. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. 8. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 9. Insert the wire into the DuraSeal splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 10. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Page 9040 2. Locate the nose piece locking tabs that are positioned on the side of the connector nose piece. The connector nose piece acts as a terminal positive assurance (TPA) and may be referred to as such. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to push in one of the locking tabs while gently pulling on the same side of the nose piece. 4. Repeat the procedure for the other locking tab and remove the nose piece. 5. Remove the wire dress cover. The following is a general procedure for wire dress cover removal. Use this procedure as a guide, some dress cover removal procedures may vary. 6. Use fingers to squeeze the 2 locking legs of the cover. Page 2568 Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. For connectors with a bolt in the dress cover, turn the bolt counterclockwise to remove the connector from the component. 2. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. Page 889 6. Gently pry the plastic terminal retainer down and carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (16-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, pull the two connector halves apart. Page 1320 Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested: - Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. - Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a component or to other harnesses. - If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A TEST LAMP TOOLS REQUIRED J 35616-200 Test Light - Probe Kit NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminate even though voltage is present. The J 35616-200 is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair of leads. To properly operate this tool use the following procedures. When testing for voltage: 1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested. When testing for ground: 1. Attach one lead to battery positive voltage. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where ground should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is ground at the point being tested. Using Connector Test Adapters USING CONNECTOR TEST ADAPTERS NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Using Fused Jumper Wires USING FUSED JUMPER WIRES TOOLS REQUIRED J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged. The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested. AFL/ECP Connectors AFL/EPC CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 5605 Open the harness by removing any tape. 2. Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. 3. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 4. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent american wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 5. Slide a section of high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing down the length of wire to be spliced. Ensure that the shrink tubing will not interfere with the splice procedure. 6. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 7. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. 8. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 9. Insert the wire into the DuraSeal splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 10. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Page 3612 Refer to the appropriate section of SI for specifications and repair procedures that are related to the vibration concern. Disclaimer Page 4399 The first connector design of the Micro-Pack 100W (1) has a white connector interface that holds the terminals. The second design of the Micro-Pack 100W (2) has a gray interface to hold the terminals. Also, the first design has terminal cavities that are further apart (3 mm centerline) and offset from the other row of terminal cavities in the connector. The second design has terminals cavities that are closer together (2.54 mm centerline) and aligned vertically. One other way to identify the second design is the thin strip of material that runs along the outside of the cavities. IMPORTANT: There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W terminals which are very similar. Ensure that you have the correct terminal before crimping the new terminal to the wire. The first design connector uses the longer terminal (1) that has a raised area in front of the recess in the terminal. The second design connector uses the shorter terminal without the raised area. Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro-Pack 100W connectors. Some Micro-Pack 100W connector disassembly procedures will vary. Use this procedure as a guide. 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 8298 3. Use a small flat-bladed tool to gently pry off the dress cover by inserting the tool under the cover opposite the harness side and prying up. 4. Remove the cover. 5. Using a small flat-bladed tool, push on the side of the nose piece retainer while pushing the nose piece forward with your thumb. This will release the terminal position assurance (TPA). 6. Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) into the corresponding terminal release cavity. The release cavities are the 2 center rows of cavities on one half of the connector. Page 6814 15. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground wire terminal. 16. Install the electrical ground wire terminal to the rivet stud. 17. Select a M6 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 18. Install the M6 conductive nut to the rivet stud and: Tighten Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb in). 19. Verify proper system operation. M6 Weld Nut Caution Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground repair. 1. If the M6 weld nut at the electrical ground location is damaged or stripped, a M7 conductive self-threading bolt may be used to secure the ground wire terminal. 2. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the surface surrounding the weld nut and allow to dry. 3. Remove any loose metal particles from the damaged or stripped weld nut with a stiff brush. 4. Select a M7 conductive self-threading bolt. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin 5. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M7 conductive self-threading bolt. Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase. 6. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground wire terminal. 7. Install the electrical ground wire terminal to the M7 conductive self-threading bolt. 8. Install the M7 conductive self-threading bolt and: Tighten Tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb in). 9. Verify proper system operation. M6 Weld Nut Alternative Repair Caution Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground repair. 1. If the electrical ground location is accessible from both sides of the panel, a M6 conductive bolt and a M6 conductive nut may be used to secure the electrical ground wire terminal. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 2. Select a location adjacent the damaged M6 weld nut having 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance behind the panel surface and 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance surrounding the new electrical ground site. 3. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the surface surrounding the ground location and allow to dry. Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled. 4. Drill a 8.5 mm (0.33 in) diameter hole through the panel. 5. Remove paint and primer from the area surrounding the 8.5 mm (0.33 in) hole until bare metal is visible. 6. Select a M6 conductive bolt. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 7. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M6 conductive bolt. Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase. 8. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground wire terminal. 9. Install the electrical ground wire terminal and the M6 conductive bolt to the ground location. 10. Select a M6 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 11. Install the M6 conductive nut to the bolt and: Page 9019 Release the tabs that are holding the wiredress cover to the connector body. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the slots on both ends of the connector body. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. J 38125-216 can also be used to remove the nose piece. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by lifting the terminal retaining tabs on the inside of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 2000 7. Apply pressure and gently rock the cover until one locking leg is unseated. 8. Continue to apply pressure and rock the cover until the second locking leg is unseated. Repeat procedure for the other side of the dress cover and remove the cover. 9. Use J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) to gently lift the terminal retaining tab while gently pulling the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 10. If the terminal is severely bent or damaged, it may be possible on some connectors to push the wire out of the front of the connector instead of Page 8080 Engine Control Module (ECM) C1 (Pin 16 To 56) Engine Control Module (ECM) C2 Page 4378 View of connector in released position. 4. Disconnect the connector from the component. 5. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Release the rear lower half of the wiredress cover. Page 5514 Page 3929 1. Connect the coolant heater cord retainers (1) to the battery cover. 2. If equipped with a 5.3L or 6.0L engine, connect the coolant heater cord to the coolant heater (1). 3. Install the coolant heater cord clip to the engine harness. 4. If equipped with a 4.2L engine, install the coolant heater cord to the coolant heater (2). 5. Install the coolant heater cord to the engine harness bracket (1). 6. Install the PCM. Refer to Powertrain Control Module Replacement. Page 1547 Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Install the ECT sensor. Tighten the sensor to 20 N.m (15 lb ft). 3. Connect the ECT sensor electrical connector (1). 4. Refill the engine coolant. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System (LL8) Draining and Filling Cooling System (LH6, LS2). Page 7556 If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the DuraSeal splice sleeves. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: - Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. - Do not use the crimp and DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 to crimp DuraSeal splice sleeve. In order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 2519 Crankshaft Position Sensor: Connector Views Engine Controls Connector End Views Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor Page 2618 7. The illustration above identifies the entry canal where the terminal release tool will be inserted, and the terminal cavity. - Terminal (1) - Entry Canal (2) 8. Insert the J-38125-553 (15315247) tool into the entry canal and pry up on the terminal retainer. The terminal retainer is a small plastic piece on the top of the terminal. The terminal retainer must be held up while the terminal is pulled out of the connector. Page 5239 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches, and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original. - The wires insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the possibility of fuel contact. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1). 5. Select the proper duraseal splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool. Refer to the Crimp and Seal Splice Table. 6. Place the duraseal splice sleeve in the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115) crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 7. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to hold the duraseal splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 8. Insert the wires into the duraseal splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel in order to prevent the wire from passing through the splice (3). 9. Close the handles of the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115), until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is applied to the splice sleeve. 10. Shrink the insulation around the splice. - Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. - Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Splicing Inline Harness Diodes SPLICING INLINE HARNESS DIODES Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure. 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode. 2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool. 5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode. Page 4670 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the DuraSeal splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of a connector. CPAs are used in all SIR System connectors and also in some connectors of other systems. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals of a connection. TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE CLIPS IMPORTANT: When making a splice in an area that may be exposed to moisture use a crimp and seal splice sleeve instead of a Splice Clip. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. Page 6705 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully raise the TPA on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA cannot be removed from the connector while there are terminals present in the connector body. View of the TPA when removed from the connector body. 4. Use the J 38125-12A tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the left side of the terminal release cavity as shown in the graphic. Use the tool to move the terminal release to the right with a gentle prying motion. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 1790 5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape. Seat Belt Schematic Icons Seat Belt Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons Page 1039 Power Door Lock Switch: Service and Repair Door Lock and Side Window Switch Replacement Passenger Side DOOR LOCK AND SIDE WINDOW SWITCH REPLACEMENT - PASSENGER REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Lift up on the front edge of the switch panel in order to release the front retaining clip. 2. Lift up on the rear edge of the switch panel in order to release the 2 rear retaining clips. 3. If equipped, disconnect the electrical connectors from the passenger door module (1). 4. If replacing only the passenger door module, remove the module from the door trim panel. 5. Disconnect the remaining electrical connectors from the switch panel. 6. If replacing only the switch panel, retain the passenger door module for transfer. 7. Remove the switch panel assembly from the vehicle. INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 1. Install the passenger door module (1) to the door trim panel. 2. Connect the electrical connector to the passenger door module. 3. If replacing the switch panel, connect the remaining electrical connectors. 4. IMPORTANT: When replacing the passenger door module, the set up procedure must be performed. If replacing the passenger door module, program the passenger door module. Refer to LINK. 5. Install the switch panel to the door trim panel, ensuring the front and rear retaining clips are fully seated. Page 5866 3. Ensure that the terminal release tang access panel is in the correct location to access the terminals. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) into the terminal release tang access slot located behind the access panel of the connector and press down on the terminal while carefully pulling the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Tyco/AMP Connectors (0.25 Cap) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (025 CAP) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component by pressing down on the connector position assurance (CPA). Page 7779 View of a typical Micro 64 connector. Depress the lock and pull the lever over and past the lock. Fuel Pressure Relief Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair Fuel Pressure Relief Fuel Pressure Relief Tools Required CH-48027 Digital Pressure Gage With CH-48027 Caution: Refer to Gasoline/Gasoline Vapors Caution. Caution: Remove the fuel tank cap and relieve the fuel system pressure before servicing the fuel system in order to reduce the risk of personal injury. After you relieve the fuel system pressure, a small amount of fuel may be released when servicing the fuel lines, the fuel injection pump, or the connections. In order to reduce the risk of personal injury, cover the fuel system components with a shop towel before disconnection. This will catch any fuel that may leak out. Place the towel in an approved container when the disconnection is complete. 1. Remove the engine cover, if required. 2. Loosen the fuel fill cap in order to relieve the fuel tank vapor pressure. 3. Remove the fuel rail service port cap. Caution: Wrap a shop towel around the fuel pressure connection in order to reduce the risk of fire and personal injury. The towel will absorb any fuel leakage that occurs during the connection of the fuel pressure gage. Place the towel in an approved container when the connection of the fuel pressure gage is complete. 4. Wrap a shop towel around the fuel rail service port. 5. Connect the CH-48027-3 (4) to the fuel rail service port. 6. Connect the CH-48027-2 (2) to the CH-48027-3 (4). 7. Place the hose on the CH-48027-2 (2) into an approved gasoline container. 8. Open the valve on the CH-48027-2 (2) in order to bleed any fuel from the fuel rail. 9. Close the valve on the CH-48027-2 (2). 10. Remove the hose on the CH-48027-2 (2) from the approved gasoline container. Important: If relieving the fuel pressure for the fuel pressure gage installation and removal, it is NOT necessary to proceed with the following steps. Notice: Clean all of the following areas before performing any disconnections in order to avoid possible contamination in the system: * The fuel pipe connections Page 7786 7. Apply pressure and gently rock the cover until one locking leg is unseated. 8. Continue to apply pressure and rock the cover until the second locking leg is unseated. Repeat procedure for the other side of the dress cover and remove the cover. 9. Use J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) to gently lift the terminal retaining tab while gently pulling the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 10. If the terminal is severely bent or damaged, it may be possible on some connectors to push the wire out of the front of the connector instead of Page 1400 6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias. Reference the appropriate service manual wiring schematic to obtain the correct diode installation position. 7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for the soldering equipment. 8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed. 9. IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode attachment points with tape. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape. Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable SPLICING TWISTED OR SHIELDED CABLE Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable. 1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splice is made. 3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire. Staggering the splices by 65 mm (2.5 in) is recommended. 4. IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical contact with the drain wire. Re-assemble the cable. Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape. - Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1). - Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire. - Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape. Page 3865 Lifter / Lash Adjuster: Service and Repair Valve Lifter Oil Manifold Replacement Valve Lifter Oil Manifold Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Remove the intake manifold. Refer to Intake Manifold Replacement. 2. Disconnect the electrical connector from the oil pressure sensor. 3. Remove the valve lifter oil manifold bolts (2). Important: Do not allow dirt or debris to enter the oil passages of the manifold. Plug as required. 4. Remove the valve lifter oil manifold (1). 5. Do not lift the manifold by the electrical lead frame. Page 503 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Ensure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the Terminal Removal Procedure. Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PULL TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL If the terminal is visibly damaged or is suspected of having a faulty connection, the terminal should be replaced. Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors: 1. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) device and/or the secondary lock. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component or separate the connectors for in-line connectors. 3. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device. 4. Insert the proper pick or removal tool into the front of the connector body. 5. IMPORTANT: On connectors with more than one terminal the service loop may not be large enough to remove the terminal and crimp on a new one. If the terminal wire does not have a large enough service loop for removal, cut the wire 5 cm (2 in) behind the connector before removal. Grasp the wire at the back of the connector body and gently push the terminal out the front of the connector body. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. If the wire needed to be cut in order to remove the terminal, gently push a small length of the same size wire through the back of the connector cavity until there is enough wire exposed in order to crimp on a new terminal. If the wire was not cut, cut the existing wire as close to the old terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 4. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. TERMINAL INSTALLATION 1. Align the terminal and pull the wire from the back of the connector in order to seat the terminal. 2. If necessary, cut the new wire to proper length and splice with existing circuit. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. 3. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply dielectric grease to the connector. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PUSH TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 1956 Diagram Information and Instructions Knock Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions Electrical Symbols Page 2361 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Kostal Connectors KOSTAL CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 1270 Horn Switch: Service and Repair HORN SWITCH REPLACEMENT REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. CAUTION: Refer to Servicing the SIR System Caution. Disable the SIR system. Refer to SIR Disabling and Enabling. 2. Remove the Inflatable Restraint Steering Wheel module. 3. Remove the horn plunger from the steering column by pressing inward to the stop and by rotating the plunger 90 degrees. 4. Disconnect the screws (1,4) from the steering wheel (3). 5. Remove the horn switch (2) from the steering wheel (3). INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 1. Install the horn switch (2) to the steering wheel (3). 2. NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice. Connect the screws (1,4) that secure the contact plate to the steering wheel (3). Tighten the screws to 5.5 N.m (49 lb in). Page 5869 Release the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the blue locking tabs on both ends of the connector. Gently slide the TPA up to the released position on both ends. 6. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-13A (GM P/N 12031876-1) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. Page 6456 4. Use a small flat-blade tool to slide the terminal position assurance (TPA) up one notch on both ends of the connector. The TPA is located underneath the wire dress cover. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 1892 MOLEX CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. 2. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. Diagram Information and Instructions Information Bus: Diagram Information and Instructions Electrical Symbols Page 738 3. Remove the dress cover by using a flat-blade tool to release the connector locking tabs and pulling off the dress cover. 4. Relieve the tension on the nose piece retainers by inserting J-38125-12A (12094429) into the single retainer slot on the end of the nose piece and gently prying out the locking tab. Repeat the process for both of the nose piece locking tabs on the opposite side of the nose piece. Page 7743 Page 893 Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size. REPAIRING A FUSIBLE LINK IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient overload protection. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. Flat Wire Repairs FLAT WIRE REPAIRS NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced. GMLAN Wiring Repairs GMLAN WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The GM Local Area Network (GMLAN) System requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working on GMLAN connectors and terminals. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items in order to repair the GMLAN wiring: Dura Seal splice sleeves - A wire stripping tool - J 38125-8 Crimping Tool (GM P/N 12085115) - J 38125-5 Ultra Torch Special Tool (GM P/N 12085116) The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. - A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors GMLAN REPAIRS IMPORTANT: When making a repair to any GMLAN network, the original wire length after the repair must be the same length as before the repair. If the network is a twisted pair, the twist must be maintained after the repair is completed. GMLAN has 2 types of networks, low speed and high speed. Low speed GMLAN has a single wire and works at slow speeds. High speed GMLAN has 2 wires in a twisted pair and works at higher speeds. For more information on GMLAN, refer to Data Link Communications Description and Operation. GMLAN CONNECTOR TERMINAL REPAIR IMPORTANT: A service terminal can be used to replace damaged connector terminals for both high speed and low speed GMLAN systems. When making a connector terminal repair on a GMLAN high speed system with twisted pair wires, do not untwist the wires more than necessary to make the repair. The terminals in the GMLAN system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are available in the J-38125. If the individual terminals are damaged on any GMLAN connection, use the appropriate connector repair procedure in order to repair the terminal. GMLAN WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 3468 Fuse Block - Underhood C5 Page 6130 6. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by pressing on the tang. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (SENSOR) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) tool into the cavity on the lower right hand face of the connector until the terminal release tang access panel slides over. Page 517 4. Slide the dress cover forward and off of the connector. 5. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front and rear of the connector. Page 8642 Page 8851 View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. 4. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers CIRCUIT PROTECTION - CIRCUIT BREAKERS A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types of circuit Page 5286 Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Diagram Information and Instructions Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions Electrical Symbols Page 5157 If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200 DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J 39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected. IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J 39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and maximum (MAX) values measured. 1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of a suspected circuit to the other. 2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J 39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep). IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value in order to record the full change. 5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling the connections or the wiring, test driving, or performing other operations. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions. 6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9. Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist. Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections TESTING FOR INTERMITTENT CONDITIONS AND POOR CONNECTIONS TOOLS REQUIRED - J 35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit - J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit When the condition is not currently present, but is indicated in DTC history, the cause may be intermittent. An intermittent may also be the cause when there is a customer complaint, but the symptom cannot be duplicated. Refer to the Symptom Table of the system that is suspect of causing the condition before trying to locate an intermittent condition. Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the following items: Wiring broken inside the insulation - Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector - Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself, and corrosion in the wire to terminal contact area, etc. - Pierced or damaged insulation can allow moisture to enter the wiring causing corrosion. The conductor can corrode inside the insulation, with little visible evidence. Look for swollen and stiff sections of wire in the suspect circuits. - Wiring which has been pinched, cut, or its insulation rubbed through may cause an intermittent open or short as the bare area touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle. - Wiring that comes in contact with hot or exhaust components - Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required, in order to verify the customer concern. - Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. - Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis and Vehicle Data Recorder operation. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any inline connectors before replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation. Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination, usually in the underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit. Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper adapter. Always use the J 35616 when probing connectors. Other causes of terminal deformation are improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT IN BUSSED ELECTRICAL CENTERS (BEC) Page 6152 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches, and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original. - The wires insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the possibility of fuel contact. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1). 5. Select the proper duraseal splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool. Refer to the Crimp and Seal Splice Table. 6. Place the duraseal splice sleeve in the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115) crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 7. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to hold the duraseal splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 8. Insert the wires into the duraseal splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel in order to prevent the wire from passing through the splice (3). 9. Close the handles of the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115), until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is applied to the splice sleeve. 10. Shrink the insulation around the splice. - Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. - Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Splicing Inline Harness Diodes SPLICING INLINE HARNESS DIODES Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure. 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode. 2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool. 5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode. Page 9078 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert a small flat-blade tool in the slot below the front loaded terminal position assurance (TPA) and pry up. 3. Remove the TPA by pulling it out of the connector. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-553 (GM P/N 15315247) on a slight upward angle into the cavity below the terminal to be removed. Ensure that the pointed on the end of the tool is facing the bottom of the terminal and it stays in contact with the terminal until it stops on the plastic terminal retainer. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 2023 3. Remove the dress cover by using a flat-blade tool to release the connector locking tabs and pulling off the dress cover. 4. Relieve the tension on the nose piece retainers by inserting J-38125-12A (12094429) into the single retainer slot on the end of the nose piece and gently prying out the locking tab. Repeat the process for both of the nose piece locking tabs on the opposite side of the nose piece. Page 7819 2. Use a small flat-bladed tool to release the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting the tool in the small recess on the side of the connector and pushing up until the TPA releases from the connector body. The TPA should raise just slightly. Do not try to remove the TPA. IMPORTANT: The TPA on this connector cannot be removed unless the terminals are removed first. The TPA will come out of the connector body, but only slightly. When the TPA is slightly raised the terminals can be removed. Using excessive force to remove the TPA with the terminals still in the connector will damage the connector. 3. Repeat the process for the other side of the connector. 4. Ensure that the TPA is in the proper position to remove the terminals. Page 3794 If a wire is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm, etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except coaxial. - Do not use the DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent American wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 7056 4. Use a small flat-blade tool to slide the terminal position assurance (TPA) up one notch on both ends of the connector. The TPA is located underneath the wire dress cover. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 5444 2. Locate the nose piece locking tabs that are positioned on the side of the connector nose piece. The connector nose piece acts as a terminal positive assurance (TPA) and may be referred to as such. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to push in one of the locking tabs while gently pulling on the same side of the nose piece. 4. Repeat the procedure for the other locking tab and remove the nose piece. 5. Remove the wire dress cover. The following is a general procedure for wire dress cover removal. Use this procedure as a guide, some dress cover removal procedures may vary. 6. Use fingers to squeeze the 2 locking legs of the cover. Page 8682 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert terminal into the appropriate terminal holder until it hits bottom and stops. The correct terminal holder is determined by the wire size. Also ensure that the terminals wings are pointing towards the former on the tool and the release locator. 5. Insert the stripped cable into the terminal. Insulation should be visible on both sides of the terminal insulation wings. 6. Compress the handles until the ratchet automatically releases. 7. Place the terminal into the appropriate cavity and assemble the connector. Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO-PACK 100W) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W connectors. These connectors are very similar but use different terminals and have some minor physical differences also. Page 3444 Page 4930 Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. FCI Connectors FCI CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 2110 Connector Anatomy Connector Repairs contains a list of all connector repairs. The connector repairs are listed by the connector manufacturer and then by connector type. If the technician cannot identify the manufacturer of the connector, refer to Identifying Connectors below. Knowing the connector manufacturer will assist in finding the correct connector repair from the following list: - Connector Position Assurance Locks - Terminal Position Assurance Locks - Bosch Connectors (0.64) Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) Bosch Connectors (BSK) Bosch Connectors (ECM) - Delphi Connectors (Micro.64) Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) Delphi Connectors (12-Way) - Tyco/AMP Connectors (CM 42-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) Tyco/AMP Connectors (025 Cap) Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) - Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) - Repairing Connector Terminals IDENTIFYING CONNECTORS Knowing the connector manufacturer is helpful when trying to locating the correct connector repair procedure. There are many different connector designs used on GM vehicles and it is sometimes difficult to identify the connector manufacturer. The information in this document should help with the identification of connector manufactures. The following connector manufacturers make most of the connectors found in GM vehicles: AFL/EPC (Alcoa Fujikura Ltd./Engineered Plastics Components) - Bosch - Delphi - FCI (Framatome Connectors International) - JAE (Japan Aviation Electronics) - JST (Japan Solderless Terminals) Page 8800 - In some cases Delphi will actually be printed on the connector. If Delphi is not printed on the connector, look for PED. In both cases there is no specific orientation for Delphi or PED and they can appear anywhere on the connector. - FCI connectors may have the FCI logo on their connectors. The logo is the letters FCI with an "A" above it. - JAE connector have JAE in small letters on their connectors. Page 6088 - In some cases Delphi will actually be printed on the connector. If Delphi is not printed on the connector, look for PED. In both cases there is no specific orientation for Delphi or PED and they can appear anywhere on the connector. - FCI connectors may have the FCI logo on their connectors. The logo is the letters FCI with an "A" above it. - JAE connector have JAE in small letters on their connectors. Page 1480 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry one side of the nose piece up to the pre-stage position. When the nose piece is in the pre-staged position, the nose piece will be raised above the connector body the length of the step in the nose piece. 7. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry the other side of the piece to the pre-stage position. If the nose piece is higher than the first step in the nose piece, gently push down on the nose piece until it meets with resistance from the connector body, you should feel the nose piece click into position. Page 2034 5. While pushing the terminal forward, insert the J 38125-24 in the release cavity above the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (43-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Page 4898 3. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. View showing depressing of the lever lock release tab. Page 4556 Open the harness by removing any tape. 2. Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. 3. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 4. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent american wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 5. Slide a section of high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing down the length of wire to be spliced. Ensure that the shrink tubing will not interfere with the splice procedure. 6. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 7. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. 8. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 9. Insert the wire into the DuraSeal splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 10. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Page 947 5. Connect the electrical connectors (2) to the SDM (1). 6. Return the carpet to the fully installed position. 7. Install the console mounting bracket to the floor panel. 8. Install the floor console. Important: The AIR BAG indicator may remain ON after the SDM has been replaced. DTC B1001 may set requiring the SDM part number to be set in multiple modules. If the indicator remains ON after enabling the SIR system, perform the diagnostic system check and follow the steps thoroughly to ensure that the SDM is set up properly. 9. Enable the SIR system. Refer to SIR Disabling and Enabling. See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming/Service and Repair Page 4822 4. Use a small flat-blade tool to slide the terminal position assurance (TPA) up one notch on both ends of the connector. The TPA is located underneath the wire dress cover. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 6053 Page 6889 difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Bosch Connectors (ECM) BOSCH CONNECTORS (ECM) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the assist lever on the top of the connector. Move the assist lever to the forward position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. ABS/TCS - StabiliTrak(R) Indicator Blinking/DTC C0196 Electronic Brake Control Module: Customer Interest ABS/TCS - StabiliTrak(R) Indicator Blinking/DTC C0196 TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 08-05-25-005 Date: October 01, 2008 Subject: Intermittent StabiliTrak(R) Indicator Light Blinking, StabiliTrak(R) Active Message Displayed, DTC C0196 Set (Reprogram Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM)) Models: 2006-2007 Buick Rainier 2006-2009 Chevrolet TrailBlazer Models 2006-2009 GMC Envoy Models 2006-2009 Saab 97X 2006-2009 Isuzu Ascender Models This bulletin provides information on two different conditions. Condition # 1 Some customers may comment on a Service StabiliTrak(R) indicator light along with a Service StabiliTrak(R) message displayed in the DIC. Upon investigation, the technician may find DTC C0196 set in history. Condition # 2 Some customers may comment on a blinking StabiliTrak(R) indicator light along with a StabiliTrak Active message displayed in the DIC during normal driving conditions. No DTCs will be found with this concern. Cause This condition may be caused by a software anomaly within the electronic brake control module (EBCM) that allowed the yaw offset to be falsely learned. Correction Important: From the controller list, select "VSES Vehicle Stability Enhancement System Control Module". If routine diagnosis using SI does not reveal any obvious cause, reprogram the EBCM using SPS with the latest software available on TIS2WEB. Refer to the Service Programming System (SPS) procedures in SI. As always, make sure your Tech 2(R) is updated with the latest software version. Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models) Page 1581 5. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove TPA from the connector. 6. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Page 4622 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Ensure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the Terminal Removal Procedure. Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PULL TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL If the terminal is visibly damaged or is suspected of having a faulty connection, the terminal should be replaced. Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors: 1. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) device and/or the secondary lock. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component or separate the connectors for in-line connectors. 3. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device. 4. Insert the proper pick or removal tool into the front of the connector body. 5. IMPORTANT: On connectors with more than one terminal the service loop may not be large enough to remove the terminal and crimp on a new one. If the terminal wire does not have a large enough service loop for removal, cut the wire 5 cm (2 in) behind the connector before removal. Grasp the wire at the back of the connector body and gently push the terminal out the front of the connector body. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. If the wire needed to be cut in order to remove the terminal, gently push a small length of the same size wire through the back of the connector cavity until there is enough wire exposed in order to crimp on a new terminal. If the wire was not cut, cut the existing wire as close to the old terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 4. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. TERMINAL INSTALLATION 1. Align the terminal and pull the wire from the back of the connector in order to seat the terminal. 2. If necessary, cut the new wire to proper length and splice with existing circuit. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. 3. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply dielectric grease to the connector. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PUSH TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 2867 Fuel Pressure: Vehicle Damage Warnings Fuel Pressure Notice Notice: Do not allow the fuel pressure to exceed the specified value because damage to the fuel pressure regulator or the fuel pressure gage may result. Page 8502 Page 8910 6. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs located on the opposite side of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover at the connector end and pry up. 7. Remove the dress cover. 8. Cut the tie wrap on the wire bundle. 9. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting a small flat-bladed tool into the small slot in the end of the slider and pushing on the TPA until it comes out of the connector. When the TPA exits the opposite side of the connector, gasp the TPA and pull it completely out of the connector. 10. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 8269 The first connector design of the Micro-Pack 100W (1) has a white connector interface that holds the terminals. The second design of the Micro-Pack 100W (2) has a gray interface to hold the terminals. Also, the first design has terminal cavities that are further apart (3 mm centerline) and offset from the other row of terminal cavities in the connector. The second design has terminals cavities that are closer together (2.54 mm centerline) and aligned vertically. One other way to identify the second design is the thin strip of material that runs along the outside of the cavities. IMPORTANT: There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W terminals which are very similar. Ensure that you have the correct terminal before crimping the new terminal to the wire. The first design connector uses the longer terminal (1) that has a raised area in front of the recess in the terminal. The second design connector uses the shorter terminal without the raised area. Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro-Pack 100W connectors. Some Micro-Pack 100W connector disassembly procedures will vary. Use this procedure as a guide. 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 3813 * Manifold absolute pressure (MAP) sensor fault * Accelerator pedal position too high, electronic throttle control * Piston protection active, knock detected * Engine oil temperature out of range * Engine oil pressure out of range * Engine oil aeration present * Engine metal over temperature protection active * Accelerator pedal position rate of increase too high, electronic throttle control * Cylinder deactivation solenoid driver circuit fault * Engine coolant temperature sensor fault * Catalytic converter over temperature protection active * Brake booster vacuum pressure low * Axle torque limiting active * Brake torque management active * Vehicle speed sensor fault * Engine coolant temperature too high * Engine not running * Vehicle speed not zero * Engine coolant temperature low * Reduced Engine Power Active, electronic throttle control * Transmission gear incorrect * Transmission range incorrect * Ignition voltage out of range * Maximum V4 mode time exceeded Listed below are the powertrain conditions that will inhibit a cylinder deactivation solenoid from being energized, with the ignition ON and the engine OFF, while using the scan tool output control function: * Engine speed not zero * Vehicle speed not zero * Transmission not in park or neutral * Ignition voltage out of range For the system description covering the hydraulic/mechanical system of cylinder deactivation, refer to Cylinder Deactivation (Active Fuel Management) System Description. Page 6515 Capacity Specifications Coolant: Capacity Specifications Cooling System ................................................................................................................................... .............................................. 11.2 quarts (10.6 liters) NOTE: All capacities are approximate. When adding, be sure to fill to the approximate level. Recheck fluid level after filling. Page 5727 2. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. OnStar(R) - Re-establishing OnStar(R) Communications Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Re-establishing OnStar(R) Communications Bulletin No.: 00-08-46-004C Date: January 17, 2008 INFORMATION Subject: Re-establishing Communications with OnStar(R) Center After Battery Disconnect Models: 2000-2008 GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn and Saab) with Digital OnStar(R) (RPO UE1) Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 00-08-46-004B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories). When servicing any of the above models and a battery cable is disconnected or power to the OnStar(R) Vehicle Communication Interface Module (VCIM) is interrupted for any reason the following procedure must be performed to verify proper Global Positioning System (GPS) function. Never swap OnStar(R) Vehicle Communication Interface Modules (VCIM) from other vehicles. Transfer of OnStar(R) modules from other vehicles should not be done. Each OnStar(R) module has a unique identification number. The VCIM has a specific Station Identification (STID). This identification number is used by the National Cellular Telephone Network and OnStar(R) systems and is stored in General Motors Vehicle History files by VIN. After completing ALL repairs to the vehicle you must perform the following procedure: Move the vehicle into an open area of the service lot. Sit in the vehicle with the engine running and the radio turned on for five minutes. Press the OnStar(R) button in the vehicle. When the OnStar(R) advisor answers ask the advisor to verify the current location of the vehicle. If the vehicle location is different than the location the OnStar(R) advisor gives contact GM Technical Assistance (TAC) and choose the OnStar(R) prompt. GM OnStar(R) TAC will assist in the diagnosis of a failed VCIM and, if appropriate, order a replacement part. Replacement parts are usually shipped out within 24 hours, and a pre-paid return package label will be included for returning the faulty part. By returning the faulty part, you will avoid a non-return core charge. Disclaimer Page 8759 Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Heated Oxygen Sensor Replacement - Bank 2 Sensor 2 Heated Oxygen Sensor Replacement - Bank 2 Sensor 2 Removal Procedure 1. Raise and suitably support the vehicle. Refer to vehicle lifting. Notice: Refer to Heated Oxygen and Oxygen Sensor Notice. 2. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) retainer. 3. Disconnect the heated oxygen sensor (HO2S) electrical connector (1). Notice: Refer to Excessive Force and Oxygen Sensor Notice. 4. Remove the HO2S (2). Installation Procedure Important: A special anti-seize compound is used on the HO2S threads. The compound consists of liquid graphite and glass beads. The graphite tends to burn away, but the glass beads remain, making the sensor easier to remove. New, or service replacement sensors already have the compound applied to the threads. If the sensor is removed from an exhaust component and if for any reason the sensor is to be reinstalled, the threads must have anti-seize compound applied before the reinstallation. Page 4193 5. Use J 41478 in order to install the oil seal into the cover bore. 1. Use a wrench and hold the hex on the installer bolt. 2. Use a second wrench and rotate the installer nut clockwise until the seal bottoms in the cover bore. 3. Remove J 41478. 4. Inspect the oil seal for proper installation. The oil seal should be installed evenly and completely into the front cover bore. 6. Install the crankshaft balancer. Refer to Crankshaft Balancer Replacement. 7. Install the radiator. Refer to Radiator Replacement (LH6, Ls2) Radiator Replacement (LL8). Page 2679 Seat Belt Tension Sensor: Diagrams SIR Connector End Views Inflatable Restraint Passenger Seat Belt Tension Retractor Sensor Page 1739 The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors. 1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position. 4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool J 38125-10A (GM P/N 12014012-1) into the front (mating end) of the connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal through the back of the connector (2). IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector. 6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. 7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily. 10. Perform system check. Delphi Connectors (12 Way) DELPHI CONNECTORS (12-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. Page 9058 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the rear TPA from the connector. 7. IMPORTANT: The front TPA cannot be removed from the connector. Only move it to the release point. Use a small flat-blade tool to move the front TPA to the release position. 8. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 9. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Molex Connectors Page 7617 Release the tabs that are holding the wiredress cover to the connector body. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the slots on both ends of the connector body. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. J 38125-216 can also be used to remove the nose piece. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by lifting the terminal retaining tabs on the inside of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 5534 Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. For connectors with a bolt in the dress cover, turn the bolt counterclockwise to remove the connector from the component. 2. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. Page 1387 breakers are used. CIRCUIT BREAKER This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high current is removed. POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) CIRCUIT BREAKER This type greatly increases its resistance when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker will re-close within a second or 2. Circuit Protection - Fuses CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSES The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and examine the element in the fuse for an open (2). If not broken (1), also check for continuity using a DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one of equal current rating. Circuit Protection - Fusible Links CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSIBLE LINKS Service and Repair Spare Tire: Service and Repair Tire Hoist and Shaft Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 2. Remove the spare tire from the spare tire carrier. 3. Remove spare wheel hoist assembly mounting bolts from the frame. 4. Remove the spare wheel hoist assembly from the vehicle. Installation Procedure 1. Install the spare wheel hoist assembly to the vehicle. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Install spare wheel hoist assembly mounting bolts to the frame. Tighten the spare wheel hoist assembly mounting bolts to the frame to 50 N.m (37 lb in). 3. Install the spare tire to the spare tire carrier. 4. Lower the vehicle. Page 4995 Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under the 5 year / 100,000 mile (160,000 km) emission warranty, use: Warranty Information (Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 6704 2. Locate the two indents of the terminal position assurance (TPA) located on the bottom of the connector body. Page 6690 The first connector design of the Micro-Pack 100W (1) has a white connector interface that holds the terminals. The second design of the Micro-Pack 100W (2) has a gray interface to hold the terminals. Also, the first design has terminal cavities that are further apart (3 mm centerline) and offset from the other row of terminal cavities in the connector. The second design has terminals cavities that are closer together (2.54 mm centerline) and aligned vertically. One other way to identify the second design is the thin strip of material that runs along the outside of the cavities. IMPORTANT: There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W terminals which are very similar. Ensure that you have the correct terminal before crimping the new terminal to the wire. The first design connector uses the longer terminal (1) that has a raised area in front of the recess in the terminal. The second design connector uses the shorter terminal without the raised area. Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro-Pack 100W connectors. Some Micro-Pack 100W connector disassembly procedures will vary. Use this procedure as a guide. 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 6263 breakers are used. CIRCUIT BREAKER This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high current is removed. POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) CIRCUIT BREAKER This type greatly increases its resistance when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker will re-close within a second or 2. Circuit Protection - Fuses CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSES The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and examine the element in the fuse for an open (2). If not broken (1), also check for continuity using a DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one of equal current rating. Circuit Protection - Fusible Links CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSIBLE LINKS Page 1108 Yaw Rate Sensor: Diagrams Antilock Brake System Connector End Views Yaw Rate and Lateral Acceleration Sensor Page 1311 Checking Aftermarket Accessories CHECKING AFTERMARKET ACCESSORIES Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits: - CAUTION: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol. - NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice. OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol. Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the cause of the problems. Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include: Power feeds connected to points other than the battery - Antenna location - Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring - Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line - Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories. Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions INDUCING INTERMITTENT FAULT CONDITIONS TOOLS REQUIRED J 25070 Heat Gun Many intermittent open or shorted circuits are affected by harness/connector movement that is caused by vibration, engine torque, bumps/rough pavement, etc. In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness if the malfunction appears to be Page 3471 Fuse Block - Underhood C9 Page 8171 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Kostal Connectors KOSTAL CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 2396 If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the DuraSeal splice sleeves. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: - Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. - Do not use the crimp and DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 to crimp DuraSeal splice sleeve. In order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 4109 20. Extract a portion of the ECT sensor harness wiring and connector from the protective conduit. Cut off the ECT sensor harness connector and wiring. 21. Determine a routing path for the ECT sensor jumper harness wires so that they can be secured TO or WITHIN an existing protective conduit. Note This step is to set up and verify the length of wiring that is required before cutting. 22. Route the ECT sensor jumper wires and then enclose them in their own protective conduit in order to VERIFY the length that is required. 23. Cut the ECT sensor jumper wires to the appropriate length. Note Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splice or connector. 24. Splice the ECT sensor jumper wires to the ORIGINAL ECT HARNESS LOCATION using DuraSeal weatherproof splices. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves in SI. Note Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splice or connector. 25. Splice the ECT sensor jumper wires to the ECT SENSOR HARNESS CONNECTOR using DuraSeal weatherproof splices. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves in SI. 26. Connect the ECT sensor harness connector to the ECT sensor. 27. Secure the ECT sensor jumper wires that are in their own protective conduit TO or WITHIN the existing harness conduit using tie straps. Important You MUST run the engine at the specified RPM and until it reaches normal operating temperature and then allow it to idle as indicated in SI. The engine MUST then be allowed to cool down in order to top off the coolant level as needed. 28. Fill the cooling system to the proper level. Refer to Cooling System Draining and Filling in SI. 29. Pressure test the cooling system. Refer to Cooling System Leak Testing in SI. 30. Use a scan tool to clear any DTCs. Relocating the Engine Coolant Heater Cord Important For reference, the procedure and graphics that are shown are from a Chevrolet Silverado, but are similar for the other vehicles listed above. 1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Ask the customer where they would prefer the extension cord to exit from the engine compartment in order to determine the required extension cord length. 3. Obtain an extension cord with the following features: - 120 volt - 14/3 gauge - 15A capacity - Three prong - Polarized plug and receptacle - Chemical resistant - Grounded terminals - Designed for use in a cold outdoor environment - Outer jacket resistant to deterioration from moisture, abrasion and exposure to sunlight - Maximum length of 2.5-3 m (8-10 ft) 4. Release enough of the clips that retain the engine coolant heater cord to the vehicle to provide the necessary length for repositioning. 5. Apply dielectric grease to the electrical contacts of the heater cord receptacle and the extension cord plug to prevent corrosion. Use GM P/N 12345579 (in Canada, use P/N 10953481) or an equivalent. 6. Connect the heater cord receptacle to the extension cord plug and wipe OFF any excess grease. Page 8767 Page 6039 Oxygen Sensor: Service Precautions Heated Oxygen Sensor Resistance Learn Reset Notice Heated Oxygen Sensor Resistance Learn Reset Notice Notice: When replacing the HO2S perform the following: * A code clear with a scan tool, regardless of whether or not a DTC is set * HO2S heater resistance learn reset with a scan tool, where available Perform the above in order to reset the HO2S resistance learned value and avoid possible HO2S failure. Locations Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Locations Electronic Components Electronic Components 36 - Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS) - Model Dependent 66 - Torque Converter Clutch (TCC) Solenoid Valve 69 - Automatic Transmission Fluid Pressure (TFP) Manual Valve Position Switch 250 - Input Speed Sensor (ISS) Assembly - Model Dependent 367a - 1-2 Shift Solenoid (SS) Valve 367b - 2-3 Shift Solenoid (SS) Valve 377 - Pressure Control (PC) Solenoid Valve 394 - 3-2 Shift Solenoid (SS) Valve Assembly 396 - Torque Converter Clutch Pulse Width Modulation (TCC PWM) Solenoid Valve Page 7994 Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. For connectors with a bolt in the dress cover, turn the bolt counterclockwise to remove the connector from the component. 2. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. Page 2785 Electronic Components 36 - Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS) - Model Dependent 66 - Torque Converter Clutch (TCC) Solenoid Valve 69 - Automatic Transmission Fluid Pressure (TFP) Manual Valve Position Switch 250 - Input Speed Sensor (ISS) Assembly - Model Dependent 367a - 1-2 Shift Solenoid (SS) Valve 367b - 2-3 Shift Solenoid (SS) Valve 377 - Pressure Control (PC) Solenoid Valve 394 - 3-2 Shift Solenoid (SS) Valve Assembly 396 - Torque Converter Clutch Pulse Width Modulation (TCC PWM) Solenoid Valve Page 7555 If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs SIR/SRS WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS, and the wiring components, such as connectors and terminals. IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system terminals. Use either an SIR/SRS pigtail or a terminated lead from the SIR Repair Kit Tray. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves, in order to repair the SIR/SRS wiring - A special crimping tool - A heat torch - An instruction manual The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides the necessary low resistance contact integrity for these sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors SIR/SRS CONNECTOR REPAIR (PLASTIC BODY AND TERMINAL METAL PIN) The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made with a special plating. This plating provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. Use the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit for repairing SIR/SRS terminals and connectors. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the repair kit. The J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit contains: Various terminated leads for sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) terminal replacement - Various connector positive assurance (CPA) locks for SIR/SRS connectors - Base of steering column pigtail connectors part number 12085514 - Yellow vinyl electrical tape Pigtail repair packs are available for SIR/SRS connectors with eight or less terminals. Only the connector body is available for connectors with more than eight terminals. The terminated leads in the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit can be used to replace damaged terminals when replacing the connector body. SIR/SRS COMPONENT WIRE PIGTAIL REPAIR IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails. A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device, not by a connector. If a wiring pigtail is damaged, you must replace the entire component, with pigtail. The inflatable restraint steering wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component. SIR/SRS WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 8681 4. Once the front 2 locks are unlocked, lift the front of the dress cover and pull it forward. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the small slot on the TPA and pushing down until the TPA releases. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to angle or rock the J 38125-21 tool when inserting it into the connector or the tool may break. Insert the J 38125-21 (GM P/N 15381651-2) tool into the round canal between the terminals cavities at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to repair Micro 64 connector terminals. The Micro 64 connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-64 (M jaw) was developed to crimp Micro 64 terminals. The J 38125-64 crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. The J 38125-64 crimping tool is also designed to crimp both the wire and the insulation at the same time. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro 64 terminals. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. 1. Cut the wire as close to the damaged terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. Page 2446 5. Insert the J 38125-557 (GM P/N 12122378) into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 6. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Connector Position Assurance Locks CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of the connector. CPAs are used in various connectors throughout the vehicle. CPAs are also used in all SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals, of the connector. Connector Repairs CONNECTOR REPAIRS Page 4327 Important: Position the gasket O-ring seal (308) onto the nipple portion of the pipe. 1. Install the seals (308) onto the coolant air bleed pipe and covers. 2. Install the coolant air bleed pipe (307) with seals (308). Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 3. Install the coolant air bleed pipe bolts (309). Tighten the bolts to 12 N.m (106 lb in). Page 3226 Page 3807 US English/Metric Conversion US English/Metric Conversion Page 5129 Note All pictures must be sent as a.jpg file. 27. E-mail a copy of the screenshot to [email protected]. In the subject line of the e-mail include the phrase "V8 Cal" as well as the complete VIN and Dealer BAC. In the body of the e-mail, include the VIN, mileage, R.O. number and BAC. Include a brief description of the customer concern and cause of the concern. Note The dealer will receive an e-mail reply after the calibrations have been validated. The e-mail reply will advise the dealer if the calibrations are OEM. 28. Allow two hours for the PQC to verify the calibrations and set up the case details. ‹› If the PQC determines that the calibrations ARE aftermarket calibrations, DO NOT contact GM Technical Assistance to discuss warranty concerns on the aftermarket calibrations. ALL questions and concerns about warranty should be directed to the dealers Fixed Operations Manager (FOM), (Warranty Manager (WM) in Canada). 29. You may call the PQC two hours after submitting the e-mail for authorization to replace the assembly. This will provide them time to receive, review and set up a case on the request. Please be prepared to provide all the usual documentation that is normally required when requesting an assembly authorization from the PQC. Warranty Information - The Dealership Service Management must be involved in any situation that would justify the use of labor operation Z1111. - Notify the Fixed Operations Manager (FOM) (Warranty Manager (WM) in Canada) of the situation. - All claims will have to be routed to the FOM (WM in Canada) for approval. - Please refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 09-00-89-016, Labor Operation Z1111 - Suspected Tampering or Vehicle Modifications for important information. For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 3776 7. The illustration above identifies the entry canal where the terminal release tool will be inserted, and the terminal cavity. - Terminal (1) - Entry Canal (2) 8. Insert the J-38125-553 (15315247) tool into the entry canal and pry up on the terminal retainer. The terminal retainer is a small plastic piece on the top of the terminal. The terminal retainer must be held up while the terminal is pulled out of the connector. Page 3485 ^ When adding proper tire air pressure, it is important to remember fluctuations in outside air temperatures and tire temperatures effect tire air pressures. ^ After you have added the proper tire pressure, if the vehicle has a DIC (after the system has updated), check to see if DIC displays are the same readings as the tire pressure gauge used (adjust as necessary). ^ Only perform a TPM sensor re-learn after a tire rotation or system part replacements and use the Tech 2(R) to initiate the relearn whenever possible to avoid invalid sensor I.D. learns. Important: Always take outside temperature and tire temperature into consideration to properly set tire pressures. Foe example, on colder days (20°F/-7°C), if setting tire pressure when the vehicle has been indoors (60°F/16°C) or the tires are warm from being driven, it will be necessary to compensate for the low outside temperature by adding 21-27 kPa (3-4 psi) more then the placecard pressure. At some later time, when the vehicle has been parked outside for a while, the tires will cool off and the pressures will drop back into the placecard range. Important: Recently, nitrogen gas (for use in inflating tires) has become available to the general customer through some retailers. The use of nitrogen gas to inflate tires is a technology used in automobile racing. Tires inflated with nitrogen gas may exhibit less of a pressure change in response to outside temperature changes. Nitrogen gas inflation is compatible with GM TPM sensors. For additional information, refer to Corporate Service Bulletin 05-03-10-020C. Important: All Models (Except the Pontiac Vibe): Do not perform a TPM relearn at PDI, the system has already been set at the Assembly Plant. Do not perform a TPM relearn after adding air to the tires. The low tire light is similar to the low fuel indicator and adding something (fuel, air) to the vehicle makes that light turn back off again. Note that because of system behavior, some vehicles must be driven a short distance before the sensors recognize the increase in pressure and turns the light off again. Pontiac Vibe Only: Do not use the TPMS reset button to turn off the light. The system will update and light will turn off when all tire pressures have been adjusted followed by short distance drive. Important: All models (except the Pontiac Vibe): Each tire monitor sensor is learned to a specific vehicle corner. When performing a TPM relearn (only after a tire rotation or replacement of a TPM sensor or Module), always use the Tech2(R) to initiate the J 46079 relearned process. Tech 2(R) - initiated relearns lock out other vehicle TPM signals that may be broadcasting in the area. Only signals initiated by the J 46079 tool will be accepted. This method avoids storing false TPM I.D.s and will prevent customers from returning with dashes (--) displayed in tire pressure readouts and/or a flashing tire pressure monitor (TPM) light. Checking the four TPM I.D.s with the Tech 2(R) prior to and following relearn to verify they are the same can prevent invalid I.D. learns. Pontiac Vibe Only: Tire Monitor Sensors are not learned to a specific vehicle corner. Do not perform a TPM Reset after tire rotation. The TPMS Reset button must only be used during pre-delivery inspection by the dealer to initialize the system (after all tire pressures have been adjusted properly) or when a Tire Pressure Monitor System component is replaced. The J 46079 tool does not work on Vibe TPM sensors. A TPMS relearn on Vibe must be preformed with a Tech 2(R) to set the TPMS Module in learn mode. The TPMS sensor IDs are entered through the Tech 2(R). Refer to SI for further Vibe TPMS information. Labor Operation and Repair Order/Warranty System Claim Required Documentation Important: The ONLY time labor operation E0726 or E0722 should be used is to diagnose for a system issue. That should ONLY occur if, at key ON, without starting the engine, the Tire Pressure Monitor (TPM) blinks for one minute and then stays on solid with a Service Tire Monitor System message (on vehicles equipped with a DIC) If that occurs, a TPM system problem exists and the system will have set a DTC. If one of these operastions is used, the following Repair Order and Warranty System documentation are required: ^ Document the customer complaint on the Repair Order. ^ Document the TPMS DTC that has set on the Repair Order. ^ Enter the TPMS DTC in the Warranty System (WINS) in the Failure Code/DTC field on the claim submission (refer to the Claims Processing Manual, Section IV, Warranty claim Data, Page 6, Item G). If the above information is not documented on the Repair Order and Warranty System, the claim may be rejected. If the Warranty Parts Center (WPC) generates a request, this repair order documentation must be sent back. Page 3235 vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide variety of actions, including: - Wiggling the harness - Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting - Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector - Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation - Relocating a harness or wires All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. Another option is, with the component commanded ON and OFF by the scan tool, move related connectors and wiring and observe the component operation. With the engine running, move related connectors and wiring while monitoring engine operation. If harness or connector movement affects the data displayed, component/system operation, or engine operation, inspect and repair the harness/connections as necessary. You may need to load the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these cases you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide good results as well. There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions, along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the circuit to these kinds of conditions. SALT WATER SPRAY Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture. Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5 percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously. HIGH TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070. Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault condition. The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis. This option does not allow for the same control, however. LOW TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect. If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to -18°C (0°F) from one end and +71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized cooling needs. Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or components in an effort to duplicate the concern. DUPLICATING FAILURE CONDITIONS - If none of the previous tests are successful, attempt to duplicate and/or capture the failure conditions. Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, where applicable, contains the conditions that were present when the DTC set. 1. Review and record Freeze Frame/Failure Records data. 2. Clear the DTCs using the scan tool. 3. Turn the key to OFF and wait 15 seconds. 4. Operate the vehicle under the same conditions that were noted in Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, as closely as possible. The vehicle must also be operating within the Conditions for Running the DTC. Refer to Conditions for Running the DTC in the supporting text if a DTC is being diagnosed. 5. Monitor DTC Status for the DTC being tested. The scan tool will indicate Ran, when the enabling conditions have been satisfied long enough for the DTC to run. The scan tool will also indicate whether the DTC passed or failed. - An alternate method is to drive the vehicle with the DMM connected to a suspected circuit. An abnormal reading on the DMM when the concern occurs, may help you locate the concern. Measuring Frequency Page 6302 MEASURING FREQUENCY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal. IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM to autorange to an appropriate range. 1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency measured. Measuring Voltage MEASURING VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit. 1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods: - Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. - Turn ON the engine. - Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls. - Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested. 3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The DMM displays the voltage measured at that point. Measuring Voltage Drop MEASURING VOLTAGE DROP NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points. Probing Electrical Connectors PROBING ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS Page 7666 3. Use a small flat-bladed tool to gently pry off the dress cover by inserting the tool under the cover opposite the harness side and prying up. 4. Remove the cover. 5. Using a small flat-bladed tool, push on the side of the nose piece retainer while pushing the nose piece forward with your thumb. This will release the terminal position assurance (TPA). 6. Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) into the corresponding terminal release cavity. The release cavities are the 2 center rows of cavities on one half of the connector. Diagrams Brake Booster Vacuum Sensor: Diagrams Engine Controls Connector End Views Brake Booster Vacuum Sensor Page 5710 2. Locate the two indents of the terminal position assurance (TPA) located on the bottom of the connector body. Page 5971 The first connector design of the Micro-Pack 100W (1) has a white connector interface that holds the terminals. The second design of the Micro-Pack 100W (2) has a gray interface to hold the terminals. Also, the first design has terminal cavities that are further apart (3 mm centerline) and offset from the other row of terminal cavities in the connector. The second design has terminals cavities that are closer together (2.54 mm centerline) and aligned vertically. One other way to identify the second design is the thin strip of material that runs along the outside of the cavities. IMPORTANT: There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W terminals which are very similar. Ensure that you have the correct terminal before crimping the new terminal to the wire. The first design connector uses the longer terminal (1) that has a raised area in front of the recess in the terminal. The second design connector uses the shorter terminal without the raised area. Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro-Pack 100W connectors. Some Micro-Pack 100W connector disassembly procedures will vary. Use this procedure as a guide. 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 5830 4. Once the front 2 locks are unlocked, lift the front of the dress cover and pull it forward. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the small slot on the TPA and pushing down until the TPA releases. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to angle or rock the J 38125-21 tool when inserting it into the connector or the tool may break. Insert the J 38125-21 (GM P/N 15381651-2) tool into the round canal between the terminals cavities at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to repair Micro 64 connector terminals. The Micro 64 connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-64 (M jaw) was developed to crimp Micro 64 terminals. The J 38125-64 crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. The J 38125-64 crimping tool is also designed to crimp both the wire and the insulation at the same time. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro 64 terminals. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. 1. Cut the wire as close to the damaged terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. Engine - Low Oil Lamp ON/Oil Leaks Oil Pressure Sensor: Customer Interest Engine - Low Oil Lamp ON/Oil Leaks TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 07-06-01-004A Date: November 25, 2008 Subject: All Vortec(R) GEN IV V8 Engines - LY2 LS4 LC9 LH6 LMG LY5 LS2 L76 LY6 L92 LS7, Low Oil Level Indicator Lamp On and/or Engine Oil Leak (Reseal Oil Pressure Sensor) Models Supercede: This bulletin is being updated to include a labor operation number for CTS-V and Corvette models. Please discard Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 07-06-01-004 (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System). Condition Some customers may comment on a low oil level indicator lamp on and/or engine oil leak. Upon further investigation, the technician may find that the oil leak is at the oil pressure sensor that is threaded into the valve lifter oil manifold (VLOM) assembly and/or engine valley cover. Correction If the engine oil leak was found to be at the engine oil pressure sensor, then remove the oil pressure sensor and reseal with a pipe sealant with Teflon or equivalent, P/N 12346004 (in Canada, P/N 10953480). Refer to Engine Oil Pressure Sensor and/or Switch Replacement in SI. Parts Information Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models) Page 3437 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link). - The wire insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. 5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold them between thumb and forefinger. 7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place. - Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction. - Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip. 8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool closes.Ensure that no strands of wire are cut. 10. Crimp the splice on each end (2). Page 4921 2. Locate the nose piece locking tabs that are positioned on the side of the connector nose piece. The connector nose piece acts as a terminal positive assurance (TPA) and may be referred to as such. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to push in one of the locking tabs while gently pulling on the same side of the nose piece. 4. Repeat the procedure for the other locking tab and remove the nose piece. 5. Remove the wire dress cover. The following is a general procedure for wire dress cover removal. Use this procedure as a guide, some dress cover removal procedures may vary. 6. Use fingers to squeeze the 2 locking legs of the cover. Page 8815 The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors. 1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position. 4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool J 38125-10A (GM P/N 12014012-1) into the front (mating end) of the connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal through the back of the connector (2). IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector. 6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. 7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily. 10. Perform system check. Delphi Connectors (12 Way) DELPHI CONNECTORS (12-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. Engine - GM dexos 1 and dexos 2(R) Oil Specifications Engine Oil: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - GM dexos 1 and dexos 2(R) Oil Specifications INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 11-00-90-001 Date: March 14, 2011 Subject: Global Information for GM dexos1(TM) and GM dexos2(TM) Engine Oil Specifications for Spark Ignited and Diesel Engines, Available Licensed Brands, and Service Fill for Adding or Complete Oil Change Models: 2012 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks Excluding All Vehicles Equipped with Duramax(TM) Diesel Engines GM dexos 1(TM) Information Center Website Refer to the following General Motors website for dexos 1(TM) information about the different licensed brands that are currently available: http://www.gmdexos.com GM dexos 1(TM) Engine Oil Trademark and Icons The dexos(TM) specification and trademarks are exclusive to General Motors, LLC. Only those oils displaying the dexos‹›(TM) trademark and icon on the front label meet the demanding performance requirements and stringent quality standards set forth in the dexos‹›(TM) specification. Look on the front label for any of the logos shown above to identify an authorized, licensed dexos 1(TM) engine oil. GM dexos 1(TM) Engine Oil Specification Important General Motors dexos 1(TM) engine oil specification replaces the previous General Motors specifications GM6094M, GM4718M and GM-LL-A-025 for most GM gasoline engines. The oil specified for use in GM passenger cars and trucks, PRIOR to the 2011 model year remains acceptable for those previous vehicles. However, dexos 1(TM) is backward compatible and can be used in those older vehicles. In North America, starting with the 2011 model year, GM introduced dexos 1(TM) certified engine oil as a factory fill and service fill for gasoline engines. The reasons for the new engine oil specification are as follows: - To meet environmental goals such as increasing fuel efficiency and reducing engine emissions. - To promote long engine life. - To minimize the number of engine oil changes in order to help meet the goal of lessening the industry's overall dependence on crude oil. dexos 1(TM) is a GM-developed engine oil specification that has been designed to provide the following benefits: - Further improve fuel economy, to meet future corporate average fuel economy (CAFE) requirements and fuel economy retention by allowing the oil to maintain its fuel economy benefits throughout the life of the oil. - More robust formulations for added engine protection and aeration performance. Specifications Wheel Fastener: Specifications Wheel Lug Nut Tighten the wheel nuts to .................................................................................................................... .................................................... 140 N.m (103 lb ft). Page 7977 Page 827 3. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. View showing depressing of the lever lock release tab. Page 9041 7. Apply pressure and gently rock the cover until one locking leg is unseated. 8. Continue to apply pressure and rock the cover until the second locking leg is unseated. Repeat procedure for the other side of the dress cover and remove the cover. 9. Use J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) to gently lift the terminal retaining tab while gently pulling the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 10. If the terminal is severely bent or damaged, it may be possible on some connectors to push the wire out of the front of the connector instead of Page 8478 1. Install the fuel level sensor (2) and electrical connector (1) to the fuel sender assembly. 2. Connect the fuel level sensor electrical connector (1). 3. Ensure the fuel level sensor retaining tabs (2) are fully engaged. 4. Install the fuel sender assembly. Page 392 pulling it through. This will prevent damage to the internal seals of the connector. Once the terminal is pushed out of the connector, cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible and pull the wire through the connector. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE The Micro-Pack 100W connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool was developed to crimp Micro-Pack 100W terminals. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 2. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert the terminal into the crimp tool until the core wings are flush with the anvil on the crimp tool. Be sure that the wings are pointed toward the crimp tool former and release the spring locator. The locator will hold the terminal in place. Inspect the alignment of the terminal wings with the crimp tool former. If the terminal wings are wider than the crimp tool former, remove the terminal and bend the terminal wings in slightly. 5. Place stripped wire into terminal. 6. Crimp the new terminal to the wire. If a jam occurs, press the emergency release to open applicator. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire perform the following procedure in order to replace Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. Page 8077 Page 8521 Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. For connectors with a bolt in the dress cover, turn the bolt counterclockwise to remove the connector from the component. 2. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. Page 2397 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the DuraSeal splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of a connector. CPAs are used in all SIR System connectors and also in some connectors of other systems. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals of a connection. TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE CLIPS IMPORTANT: When making a splice in an area that may be exposed to moisture use a crimp and seal splice sleeve instead of a Splice Clip. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. Page 2979 1. Install the MAF/IAT sensor (3) to the air filter element (6). 2. Install the air filter element (6) and MAF/IAT sensor (3) to the lower air cleaner housing/washer solvent tank assembly (4). Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. Important: Ensure the air inlet duct (5) is properly positioned in the lower air cleaner housing/washer solvent tank assembly (4) before installing the air cleaner cover (2). 3. Install the air cleaner cover (2) and secure with 4 retaining screws (1). Tighten the screws to 4 N.m (35 lb in). 4. Install the radiator support diagonal brace. 5. Connect the MAF/IAT sensor electrical connector (1). 6. Install the air cleaner outlet duct. Page 3475 3. Install the fuse relay center bolts (3). Tighten the relay center bolts to 6 N.m (53 lb in). 4. Install the harness end bolts (2). 5. Install the fuse relay center cover (1) over the relay center bolts. Press downward to engage the tabs. 6. Install the junction block cover. Press downward to engage the tabs. Page 5587 7. Pressing the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool in the release cavity of the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and crimper in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (DOOR MODULE) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Side view of connector. View of top of connector. 1. Locate the assist lever and lock on the top of the connector. Page 8735 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the DuraSeal splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of a connector. CPAs are used in all SIR System connectors and also in some connectors of other systems. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals of a connection. TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE CLIPS IMPORTANT: When making a splice in an area that may be exposed to moisture use a crimp and seal splice sleeve instead of a Splice Clip. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. Page 2101 Release the tabs that are holding the wiredress cover to the connector body. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the slots on both ends of the connector body. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. J 38125-216 can also be used to remove the nose piece. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by lifting the terminal retaining tabs on the inside of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 6387 11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the solder equipment. 12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. 13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to cover the first piece of tape. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE SLEEVES TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit IMPORTANT: Use only dura seal splice sleeves. Other splice sleeves may not protect the splice from moisture or provide a good electrical connection. Use duraseal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. Use duraseal splice sleeves where there is special requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire using duraseal splice sleeves. Page 2601 Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. FCI Connectors FCI CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 8566 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry one side of the nose piece up to the pre-stage position. When the nose piece is in the pre-staged position, the nose piece will be raised above the connector body the length of the step in the nose piece. 7. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry the other side of the piece to the pre-stage position. If the nose piece is higher than the first step in the nose piece, gently push down on the nose piece until it meets with resistance from the connector body, you should feel the nose piece click into position. Page 6418 It is very important to use the correct test adapter when testing for proper terminal contact of fuses and relays in a bussed electrical center (BEC). Use J-35616-35 to test for proper terminal contact. Failure to use J-35616-35 can result in improper diagnosis of the BEC. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Separate the connector halves. 2. Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body. 3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J-38125 , test that the retention force is significantly different between a good terminal and a suspect terminal. Replace the female terminal in question. FLAT WIRE (DOCK AND LOCK) CONNECTORS There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock) connectors on the harness side or the component side. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Remove the component in question. 2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side of the connector as oil from your skin may be a source of contamination as well. 3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other imperfections that could cause poor terminal contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are uniform and free of damage or deformation. 4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the on the flat wire harness connector in order to test the circuit in question. CONTROL MODULE/COMPONENT VOLTAGE AND GROUNDS Poor voltage or ground connections can cause widely varying symptoms. Test all control module voltage supply circuits. Many vehicles have multiple circuits supplying voltage to a control module. Other components in the system may have separate voltage supply circuits that may also need to be tested. Inspect connections at the module/component connectors, fuses, and any intermediate connections between the voltage source and the module/component. A test lamp or a DMM may indicate that voltage is present, but neither tests the ability of the circuit to carry sufficient current. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Power Distribution Schematics. - Test all control module ground and system ground circuits. The control module may have multiple ground circuits. Other components in the system may have separate grounds that may also need to be tested. Inspect grounds for clean and tight connections at the grounding point. Inspect the connections at the component and in splice packs, where applicable. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Ground Distribution Schematics. TEMPERATURE SENSITIVITY - An intermittent condition may occur when a component/connection reaches normal operating temperature. The condition may occur only when the component/connection is cold, or only when the component/connection is hot. - Freeze Frame, Failure Records, Snapshot, or Vehicle Data Recorder data may help with this type of intermittent condition, where applicable. - If the intermittent is related to heat, review the data for a relationship with the following: High ambient temperatures - Underhood/engine generated heat - Circuit generated heat due to a poor connection, or high electrical load - Higher than normal load conditions, towing, etc. - If the intermittent is related to cold, review the data for the following: Low ambient temperatures-In extremely low temperatures, ice may form in a connection or component. Inspect for water intrusion. - The condition only occurs on a cold start. - The condition goes away when the vehicle warms up. - Information from the customer may help to determine if the trouble follows a pattern that is temperature related. - If temperature is suspected of causing an intermittent fault condition, attempt to duplicate the condition. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required. ELECTROMAGNETIC INTERFERENCE (EMI) AND ELECTRICAL NOISE Some electrical components/circuits are sensitive to electromagnetic interference (EMI) or other types of electrical noise. Inspect for the following conditions: A misrouted harness that is too close to high voltage/high current devices such as secondary ignition components, motors, generator etc-These components may induce electrical noise on a circuit that could interfere with normal circuit operation. - Electrical system interference caused by a malfunctioning relay, or a control module driven solenoid or switch-These conditions can cause a sharp electrical surge. Normally, the condition will occur when the malfunctioning component is operating. - Improper installation of non-factory or aftermarket add on accessories such as lights, 2-way radios, amplifiers, electric motors, remote starters, alarm systems, cell phones, etc-These accessories may lead to interference while in use, but do not fail when the accessories are not in use. - Test for an open diode across the A/C compressor clutch and for other open diodes. Some relays may contain a clamping diode. - The generator may be allowing AC noise into the electrical system. INCORRECT CONTROL MODULE - There are only a few situations where reprogramming a control module is appropriate: A new service control module is installed. Page 2113 - JST connectors have JST in small letters on their connectors, similar to that above. The location of the logo will vary with the connector size and style. - Kostel has an "LK" with a circle around it. These connector are usually used as a transmissions connection and are currently use on some Cadillac vehicles. Page 1305 Page 4499 - In some cases Delphi will actually be printed on the connector. If Delphi is not printed on the connector, look for PED. In both cases there is no specific orientation for Delphi or PED and they can appear anywhere on the connector. - FCI connectors may have the FCI logo on their connectors. The logo is the letters FCI with an "A" above it. - JAE connector have JAE in small letters on their connectors. Page 6731 2. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully push the terminal position assurance (TPA) towards the face of the connector on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA is fragile and may break if not done carefully. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. 3. Use the J 38125-215 tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 7443 4. Remove the fuel sender assembly (2) and seal (3). Discard the seal. Caution: Refer to Fuel Storage Caution. 5. Clean the fuel sender sealing surfaces (4). Important: Some lock ring were manufactured with DO NOT REUSE stamped into them. These lock rings may be reused if they are not damaged or warped. Important: Inspect the lock ring for damage due to improper removal or installation procedures. If damage is found, install a NEW lock ring. Important: Check the lock ring for flatness. 6. Place the lock ring on a flat surface. Measure the clearance between to lock ring and the flat surface using a feeler gage at 7 points. 7. If the warpage is less than 0.41 mm (0.016 in), the lock ring does not require replacement. 8. If the warpage is greater than 0.41 mm (0.016 in), the lock ring must be replaced. Installation Procedure Page 4547 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert a small flat-blade tool in the slot below the front loaded terminal position assurance (TPA) and pry up. 3. Remove the TPA by pulling it out of the connector. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-553 (GM P/N 15315247) on a slight upward angle into the cavity below the terminal to be removed. Ensure that the pointed on the end of the tool is facing the bottom of the terminal and it stays in contact with the terminal until it stops on the plastic terminal retainer. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 1822 1. Apply sealant to the threads of the oil pressure sensor. Refer to Sealers, Adhesives, and Lubricants for the correct part number. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Using J 41712 or equivalent, install the oil pressure sensor. Tighten the sensor to 35 N.m (26 lb ft). 3. Connect the oil pressure sensor electrical connector (1). 4. Install the intake manifold. Refer to Intake Manifold Replacement. Page 3302 2. Use a small flat-bladed tool to release the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting the tool in the small recess on the side of the connector and pushing up until the TPA releases from the connector body. The TPA should raise just slightly. Do not try to remove the TPA. IMPORTANT: The TPA on this connector cannot be removed unless the terminals are removed first. The TPA will come out of the connector body, but only slightly. When the TPA is slightly raised the terminals can be removed. Using excessive force to remove the TPA with the terminals still in the connector will damage the connector. 3. Repeat the process for the other side of the connector. 4. Ensure that the TPA is in the proper position to remove the terminals. Page 7049 TERMINAL REMOVAL Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors. 1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA) device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1). 3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 4. Gently pull the cable and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector. 5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal, refer to Terminal Repair. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3. Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector. REINSTALLING TERMINAL 1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly, refer to Wiring Repairs. 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3. Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) DELPHI CONNECTORS (WEATHER PACK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 8187 4. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the rear of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. 5. Once the locking tabs are unlocked, slide the inner connector out of the rear of the connector housing. Page 2566 - A control module from another vehicle is installed. - Revised software/calibration files have been released for this vehicle. - IMPORTANT: DO NOT re-program the control module with the SAME software/calibration files that are already present in the control module. This is not an effective repair for any type of concern. Verify that the control module contains the correct software/calibration. If incorrect programming is found, reprogram the control module with the most current software/calibration. Refer to Control Module References for replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Testing for Short to Ground TESTING FOR SHORT TO GROUND NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 4. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit. With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is a short to ground in the circuit. Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2. Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). - When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. - If the DMM does not display voltage 4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is shorted. Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A DIGITAL MULTIMETER NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the powertrain control module (PCM), should only be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200 Digital Multimeter (DMM). The J 39200 instruction manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminage even though voltage is present. The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity. IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading. Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the measurement. Page 8758 1. Connect the HO2S electrical connector (2). 2. Install the CPA retainer. Important: A special anti-seize compound is used on the HO2S threads. The compound consists of liquid graphite and glass beads. The graphite tends to burn away, but the glass beads remain, making the sensor easier to remove. New, or service replacement sensors already have the compound applied to the threads. If the sensor is removed from an exhaust component and if for any reason the sensor is to be reinstalled, the threads must have anti-seize compound applied before the reinstallation. 3. If reinstalling the old sensor, coat the threads with anti-seize compound GM P/N 12377953, or equivalent. Notice: Refer to Component Fastener Tightening Notice. Important: If the HO2S sensor is connected to the main wiring harness during installation. Rotate the HO2S sensor several turns counterclockwise before threading the HO2S sensor into the catalytic converter. This action of initially reverse winding of the pigtail wires will prevent a condition where the HO2S sensor pigtail wires become severely twisted or binding once the HO2S sensor is installed into the catalytic converter. 4. Install the HO2S (2). Tighten the sensor to 42 N.m (31 lb ft). 5. Lower the vehicle. Page 8195 6. Gently pry the plastic terminal retainer down and carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (16-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, pull the two connector halves apart. Page 767 11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the solder equipment. 12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. 13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to cover the first piece of tape. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE SLEEVES TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit IMPORTANT: Use only dura seal splice sleeves. Other splice sleeves may not protect the splice from moisture or provide a good electrical connection. Use duraseal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. Use duraseal splice sleeves where there is special requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire using duraseal splice sleeves. Page 5865 6. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by pressing on the tang. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (SENSOR) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) tool into the cavity on the lower right hand face of the connector until the terminal release tang access panel slides over. Page 1439 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (BSK) BOSCH CONNECTORS (BSK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 3. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 4. Insert the J 38125-561 tool into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 5. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is Page 4231 Inspect the sprockets for proper alignment. The mark on the camshaft sprocket (1) should be located in the 6 o'clock position and the mark on the crankshaft sprocket (2) should be located in the 12 o'clock position. Page 9008 MEASURING FREQUENCY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal. IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM to autorange to an appropriate range. 1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency measured. Measuring Voltage MEASURING VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit. 1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods: - Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. - Turn ON the engine. - Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls. - Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested. 3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The DMM displays the voltage measured at that point. Measuring Voltage Drop MEASURING VOLTAGE DROP NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points. Probing Electrical Connectors PROBING ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS Page 1989 - In some cases Delphi will actually be printed on the connector. If Delphi is not printed on the connector, look for PED. In both cases there is no specific orientation for Delphi or PED and they can appear anywhere on the connector. - FCI connectors may have the FCI logo on their connectors. The logo is the letters FCI with an "A" above it. - JAE connector have JAE in small letters on their connectors. Page 5895 Knock Sensor: Description and Operation Knock Sensor (KS) System Description Purpose The knock sensor (KS) system enables the control module to control the ignition timing for the best possible performance while protecting the engine from potentially damaging levels of detonation. The control module uses the KS system to test for abnormal engine noise that may indicate detonation, also known as spark knock. Sensor Description This knock sensor (KS) system uses one or 2 flat response 2-wire sensors. The sensor uses piezo-electric crystal technology that produces an AC voltage signal of varying amplitude and frequency based on the engine vibration or noise level. The control module receives the KS signal through a signal circuit. The KS ground is supplied by the control module through a low reference circuit. The control module learns a minimum noise level, or background noise, at idle from the KS and uses calibrated values for the rest of the RPM range. The control module uses the minimum noise level to calculate a noise channel. A normal KS signal will ride within the noise channel. As engine speed and load change, the noise channel upper and lower parameters will change to accommodate the normal KS signal, keeping the signal within the channel. In order to determine which cylinders are knocking, the control module only uses KS signal information when each cylinder is near top dead center (TDC) of the firing stroke. If knock is present, the signal will range outside of the noise channel. If the control module has determined that knock is present, it will retard the ignition timing to attempt to eliminate the knock. The control module will always try to work back to a zero compensation level, or no spark retard. An abnormal KS signal will stay outside of the noise channel or will not be present. KS diagnostics are calibrated to detect faults with the KS circuitry inside the control module, the KS wiring, or the KS voltage output. Some diagnostics are also calibrated to detect constant noise from an outside influence such as a loose/damaged component or excessive engine mechanical noise. Page 6931 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Locations Knock Sensor: Locations Engine Controls Component Views Lower Left Side of Engine - Rear 1 - G108 2 - Knock Sensor (KS) 1 - Left 3 - Engine 4 - G107 5 - Engine Harness Lower Right Side of the Engine - Rear Page 8234 Page 8662 View of connector in released position. 4. Disconnect the connector from the component. 5. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Release the rear lower half of the wiredress cover. Page 8407 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert terminal into the appropriate terminal holder until it hits bottom and stops. The correct terminal holder is determined by the wire size. Also ensure that the terminals wings are pointing towards the former on the tool and the release locator. 5. Insert the stripped cable into the terminal. Insulation should be visible on both sides of the terminal insulation wings. 6. Compress the handles until the ratchet automatically releases. 7. Place the terminal into the appropriate cavity and assemble the connector. Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO-PACK 100W) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W connectors. These connectors are very similar but use different terminals and have some minor physical differences also. Page 5424 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (BSK) BOSCH CONNECTORS (BSK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 3. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 4. Insert the J 38125-561 tool into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 5. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is Page 5163 View of connector in released position. 4. Disconnect the connector from the component. 5. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Release the rear lower half of the wiredress cover. Page 3878 Important: When reusing the valve train components, always install the components to the original location and position. The valve lash is net build, no valve adjustment is required. 1. Lubricate the valve rocker arms and pushrods with clean engine oil. 2. Lubricate the flange of the valve rocker arm bolts with clean engine oil. 3. Lubricate the flange or washer surface of the bolt that will contact the valve rocker arm. 4. Install the valve rocker arm pivot support. Important: Make sure that the pushrods seat properly to the valve lifter sockets. 5. Install the pushrods. Important: Verify that the pushrods seat properly to the ends of the rocker arms. DO NOT tighten the rocker arm bolts at this time. 6. Install the rocker arms and bolts. Page 7504 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert terminal into the appropriate terminal holder until it hits bottom and stops. The correct terminal holder is determined by the wire size. Also ensure that the terminals wings are pointing towards the former on the tool and the release locator. 5. Insert the stripped cable into the terminal. Insulation should be visible on both sides of the terminal insulation wings. 6. Compress the handles until the ratchet automatically releases. 7. Place the terminal into the appropriate cavity and assemble the connector. Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO-PACK 100W) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W connectors. These connectors are very similar but use different terminals and have some minor physical differences also. Service and Repair Exhaust Pipe/Muffler Hanger: Service and Repair Exhaust System Insulator, Hanger, Bracket Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 2. Disconnect the heated oxygen sensor (H2OS) electrical connector. 3. Remove the nuts that secure the catalytic converter pipe to the exhaust manifold. 4. Discard the old exhaust seal. Do NOT reuse the seal. 5. Remove the nuts that secure the catalytic converter pipe to the muffler. 6. Remove the bolt securing the exhaust hanger to the transmission mount. 7. Remove the transmission mount. 8. Remove the catalytic converter and exhaust hanger assembly from the vehicle. 9. Remove the exhaust hanger from the catalytic converter. Installation Procedure Page 5814 difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Bosch Connectors (ECM) BOSCH CONNECTORS (ECM) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the assist lever on the top of the connector. Move the assist lever to the forward position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 4386 11. Insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) into the 2 triangular cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 12. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE 1. Prior to installation the terminal must be aligned so the (1) coding lugs align with the (2) coding grooves on the connector. 2. Once the terminal is aligned, slide the terminal into the cavity until the retainer has engaged in the cavity of the connector. 3. Slide the TPA in the connector body and seat it using a small flat bladed tool. The TPA is seated when it is flush with the contact housing. 4. Secure the wires to the connector body using a tie wrap and replace the dress cover and grommet. Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) BOSCH CONNECTORS (2.8 JPT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Pull out the slider on the connector position assurance (CPA) until it is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 7000 Page 7578 - The transmission control module (TCM) - The ECM The interaction between high speed GMLAN and class 2 is assured by ECM, which acts as a gateway between the links. Page 3096 Contamination Mixing conventional green coolant with DEX-COOL(R) will degrade the service interval from 5 yrs./150,000 miles (240,000 km) to 2 yrs./30,000 miles (50,000 km) if left in the contaminated condition. If contamination occurs, the cooling system must be flushed twice immediately and re-filled with a 50/50 mixture of DEX-COOL(R) and clean water in order to preserve the enhanced properties and extended service interval of DEX-COOL(R). After 5 years/150,000 miles (240,000 km) After 5 yrs/150,000 miles (240,000 km), the coolant should be changed, preferably using a coolant exchanger. If the vehicle was originally equipped with DEX-COOL(R) and has not had problems with contamination from non-DEX-COOL(R) coolants, then the service interval remains the same, and the coolant does not need to be changed for another 5 yrs/150,000 miles (240,000 km) Equipment (Coolant Exchangers) The preferred method of performing coolant replacement is to use a coolant exchanger. A coolant exchanger can replace virtually all of the old coolant with new coolant. Coolant exchangers can be used to perform coolant replacement without spillage, and facilitate easy waste collection. They can also be used to lower the coolant level in a vehicle to allow for less messy servicing of cooling system components. It is recommended that you use a coolant exchanger with a vacuum feature facilitates removing trapped air from the cooling system. This is a substantial time savings over repeatedly thermo cycling the vehicle and topping-off the radiator. The vacuum feature also allows venting of a hot system to relieve system pressure. Approved coolant exchangers are available through the GMDE (General Motors Dealer Equipment) program. For refilling a cooling system that has been partially or fully drained for repairs other than coolant replacement, the Vac-N-Fill Coolant Refill Tool (GE-47716) is recommended to facilitate removal of trapped air from the cooling system during refill. Disclaimer Page 6881 It is very important to use the correct test adapter when testing for proper terminal contact of fuses and relays in a bussed electrical center (BEC). Use J-35616-35 to test for proper terminal contact. Failure to use J-35616-35 can result in improper diagnosis of the BEC. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Separate the connector halves. 2. Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body. 3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J-38125 , test that the retention force is significantly different between a good terminal and a suspect terminal. Replace the female terminal in question. FLAT WIRE (DOCK AND LOCK) CONNECTORS There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock) connectors on the harness side or the component side. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Remove the component in question. 2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side of the connector as oil from your skin may be a source of contamination as well. 3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other imperfections that could cause poor terminal contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are uniform and free of damage or deformation. 4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the on the flat wire harness connector in order to test the circuit in question. CONTROL MODULE/COMPONENT VOLTAGE AND GROUNDS Poor voltage or ground connections can cause widely varying symptoms. Test all control module voltage supply circuits. Many vehicles have multiple circuits supplying voltage to a control module. Other components in the system may have separate voltage supply circuits that may also need to be tested. Inspect connections at the module/component connectors, fuses, and any intermediate connections between the voltage source and the module/component. A test lamp or a DMM may indicate that voltage is present, but neither tests the ability of the circuit to carry sufficient current. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Power Distribution Schematics. - Test all control module ground and system ground circuits. The control module may have multiple ground circuits. Other components in the system may have separate grounds that may also need to be tested. Inspect grounds for clean and tight connections at the grounding point. Inspect the connections at the component and in splice packs, where applicable. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Ground Distribution Schematics. TEMPERATURE SENSITIVITY - An intermittent condition may occur when a component/connection reaches normal operating temperature. The condition may occur only when the component/connection is cold, or only when the component/connection is hot. - Freeze Frame, Failure Records, Snapshot, or Vehicle Data Recorder data may help with this type of intermittent condition, where applicable. - If the intermittent is related to heat, review the data for a relationship with the following: High ambient temperatures - Underhood/engine generated heat - Circuit generated heat due to a poor connection, or high electrical load - Higher than normal load conditions, towing, etc. - If the intermittent is related to cold, review the data for the following: Low ambient temperatures-In extremely low temperatures, ice may form in a connection or component. Inspect for water intrusion. - The condition only occurs on a cold start. - The condition goes away when the vehicle warms up. - Information from the customer may help to determine if the trouble follows a pattern that is temperature related. - If temperature is suspected of causing an intermittent fault condition, attempt to duplicate the condition. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required. ELECTROMAGNETIC INTERFERENCE (EMI) AND ELECTRICAL NOISE Some electrical components/circuits are sensitive to electromagnetic interference (EMI) or other types of electrical noise. Inspect for the following conditions: A misrouted harness that is too close to high voltage/high current devices such as secondary ignition components, motors, generator etc-These components may induce electrical noise on a circuit that could interfere with normal circuit operation. - Electrical system interference caused by a malfunctioning relay, or a control module driven solenoid or switch-These conditions can cause a sharp electrical surge. Normally, the condition will occur when the malfunctioning component is operating. - Improper installation of non-factory or aftermarket add on accessories such as lights, 2-way radios, amplifiers, electric motors, remote starters, alarm systems, cell phones, etc-These accessories may lead to interference while in use, but do not fail when the accessories are not in use. - Test for an open diode across the A/C compressor clutch and for other open diodes. Some relays may contain a clamping diode. - The generator may be allowing AC noise into the electrical system. INCORRECT CONTROL MODULE - There are only a few situations where reprogramming a control module is appropriate: A new service control module is installed. Page 7791 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) and slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. Page 8578 3. Ensure that the terminal release tang access panel is in the correct location to access the terminals. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) into the terminal release tang access slot located behind the access panel of the connector and press down on the terminal while carefully pulling the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Tyco/AMP Connectors (0.25 Cap) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (025 CAP) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component by pressing down on the connector position assurance (CPA). Page 1728 View of a typical Micro 64 connector. Depress the lock and pull the lever over and past the lock. Page 4387 5. Insert the J 38125-557 (GM P/N 12122378) into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 6. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Connector Position Assurance Locks CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of the connector. CPAs are used in various connectors throughout the vehicle. CPAs are also used in all SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals, of the connector. Connector Repairs CONNECTOR REPAIRS Page 4663 If a wire is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm, etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except coaxial. - Do not use the DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent American wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 7842 US English/Metric Conversion US English/Metric Conversion Page 8063 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Start in the middle and gradually move the heat barrel to the open ends of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Heated Oxygen Sensor Wiring Repairs HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being obstructed. If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. - Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks, etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire. - Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance. - To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector. Page 786 Notice: Refer to Handling Electrostatic Discharge Sensitive Parts Notice. Important: * It is not necessary to disconnect the ECM electrical connectors in order to remove the ECM from the ECM/TCM bracket. Only disconnect the electrical connectors if servicing of component requires disconnecting of the electrical connectors. * Remove any debris from around the ECM connector surfaces before servicing the ECM. Inspect the ECM module connector gaskets when diagnosing or replacing the ECM. Ensure that the gaskets are installed correctly. The gaskets prevent contaminant intrusion into the ECM. Disconnect the engine wiring harness electrical connectors from the ECM. 6. Release the ECM/TCM bracket upper retainers (1). 7. Tilt the ECM away from the bracket and remove the ECM. Page 2731 1. Position the steering wheel sensor (3) to the steering column. 2. Position the steering wheel sensor retainer plate (2) to the steering column. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 3. Install the steering wheel position sensor retainer screws (1). Tighten the screws to 10 N.m (89 lb in). 4. Remove the steering wheel position sensor anti-rotation pin from the sensor. 5. Connect the electrical connector to the steering wheel position sensor. 6. Install the intermediate shaft to the steering column. Refer to Upper Intermediate Steering Shaft Replacement. 7. Enable the SIR system. Refer to SIR Disabling and Enabling. Page 6480 5. While pushing the terminal forward, insert the J 38125-24 in the release cavity above the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (43-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Page 526 7. The illustration above identifies the entry canal where the terminal release tool will be inserted, and the terminal cavity. - Terminal (1) - Entry Canal (2) 8. Insert the J-38125-553 (15315247) tool into the entry canal and pry up on the terminal retainer. The terminal retainer is a small plastic piece on the top of the terminal. The terminal retainer must be held up while the terminal is pulled out of the connector. Page 5495 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the DuraSeal splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of a connector. CPAs are used in all SIR System connectors and also in some connectors of other systems. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals of a connection. TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE CLIPS IMPORTANT: When making a splice in an area that may be exposed to moisture use a crimp and seal splice sleeve instead of a Splice Clip. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. Page 1302 Page 875 5. Once the nose piece retainers are relaxed, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should raise slightly. 6. On the opposite side of the nose piece, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should release completely. If the nose piece does not come off, repeat the procedure on the opposite side. Page 7050 The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors. 1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position. 4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool J 38125-10A (GM P/N 12014012-1) into the front (mating end) of the connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal through the back of the connector (2). IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector. 6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. 7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily. 10. Perform system check. Delphi Connectors (12 Way) DELPHI CONNECTORS (12-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. Page 7394 3. Ensure that the terminal release tang access panel is in the correct location to access the terminals. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) into the terminal release tang access slot located behind the access panel of the connector and press down on the terminal while carefully pulling the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Tyco/AMP Connectors (0.25 Cap) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (025 CAP) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component by pressing down on the connector position assurance (CPA). Page 8775 Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Page 132 Method 1 Method 2 Page 8294 3. Remove the dress cover by using a flat-blade tool to release the connector locking tabs and pulling off the dress cover. 4. Relieve the tension on the nose piece retainers by inserting J-38125-12A (12094429) into the single retainer slot on the end of the nose piece and gently prying out the locking tab. Repeat the process for both of the nose piece locking tabs on the opposite side of the nose piece. Page 5933 Utility/Van Zoning UTILITY/VAN ZONING Page 8296 7. The illustration above identifies the entry canal where the terminal release tool will be inserted, and the terminal cavity. - Terminal (1) - Entry Canal (2) 8. Insert the J-38125-553 (15315247) tool into the entry canal and pry up on the terminal retainer. The terminal retainer is a small plastic piece on the top of the terminal. The terminal retainer must be held up while the terminal is pulled out of the connector. Page 7929 5. Remove paint and primer from the area surrounding the 10 mm (0.40 in) until bare metal is visible. Important The M6 conductive rivet stud as shown, can accommodate a panel thickness range of 0.7-4.2 mm (0.03-0.17 in). If there are layers of sheet metal, they should be touching without any air gaps to ensure a good ground. 6. Select a M6 conductive rivet stud. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. Note Use the GE-50317 rivet stud tool kit. 7. Place the M6 conductive rivet stud (1) in the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole. Assemble the rivet stud tool (2) with the groove and flare side facing the rivet stud, then the washer and the M6 nut (3). 8. Using a wrench on the rivet stud tool, and a socket on the M6 nut, secure the M6 conductive rivet stud. 9. Ensure the new rivet stud is securely fastened, WITHOUT ANY detectable movement. 10. Completely wrap the threads of the rivet stud with painters tape or equivalent. Page 5610 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link). - The wire insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. 5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold them between thumb and forefinger. 7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place. - Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction. - Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip. 8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool closes.Ensure that no strands of wire are cut. 10. Crimp the splice on each end (2). Page 337 Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM) Page 8235 Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Page 5411 vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide variety of actions, including: - Wiggling the harness - Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting - Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector - Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation - Relocating a harness or wires All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. Another option is, with the component commanded ON and OFF by the scan tool, move related connectors and wiring and observe the component operation. With the engine running, move related connectors and wiring while monitoring engine operation. If harness or connector movement affects the data displayed, component/system operation, or engine operation, inspect and repair the harness/connections as necessary. You may need to load the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these cases you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide good results as well. There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions, along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the circuit to these kinds of conditions. SALT WATER SPRAY Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture. Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5 percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously. HIGH TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070. Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault condition. The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis. This option does not allow for the same control, however. LOW TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect. If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to -18°C (0°F) from one end and +71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized cooling needs. Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or components in an effort to duplicate the concern. DUPLICATING FAILURE CONDITIONS - If none of the previous tests are successful, attempt to duplicate and/or capture the failure conditions. Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, where applicable, contains the conditions that were present when the DTC set. 1. Review and record Freeze Frame/Failure Records data. 2. Clear the DTCs using the scan tool. 3. Turn the key to OFF and wait 15 seconds. 4. Operate the vehicle under the same conditions that were noted in Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, as closely as possible. The vehicle must also be operating within the Conditions for Running the DTC. Refer to Conditions for Running the DTC in the supporting text if a DTC is being diagnosed. 5. Monitor DTC Status for the DTC being tested. The scan tool will indicate Ran, when the enabling conditions have been satisfied long enough for the DTC to run. The scan tool will also indicate whether the DTC passed or failed. - An alternate method is to drive the vehicle with the DMM connected to a suspected circuit. An abnormal reading on the DMM when the concern occurs, may help you locate the concern. Measuring Frequency Page 7790 The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors. 1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position. 4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool J 38125-10A (GM P/N 12014012-1) into the front (mating end) of the connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal through the back of the connector (2). IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector. 6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. 7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily. 10. Perform system check. Delphi Connectors (12 Way) DELPHI CONNECTORS (12-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. Page 732 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the rear TPA from the connector. 7. IMPORTANT: The front TPA cannot be removed from the connector. Only move it to the release point. Use a small flat-blade tool to move the front TPA to the release position. 8. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 9. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Molex Connectors Page 4563 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches, and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original. - The wires insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the possibility of fuel contact. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1). 5. Select the proper duraseal splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool. Refer to the Crimp and Seal Splice Table. 6. Place the duraseal splice sleeve in the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115) crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 7. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to hold the duraseal splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 8. Insert the wires into the duraseal splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel in order to prevent the wire from passing through the splice (3). 9. Close the handles of the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115), until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is applied to the splice sleeve. 10. Shrink the insulation around the splice. - Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. - Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Splicing Inline Harness Diodes SPLICING INLINE HARNESS DIODES Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure. 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode. 2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool. 5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode. Page 7287 Note The dealer will receive an e-mail reply after the calibrations have been validated. The e-mail reply will advise the dealer if the calibrations are OEM. 28. Allow two hours for the PQC to verify the calibrations and set up the case details. ‹› If the PQC determines that the calibrations ARE aftermarket calibrations, DO NOT contact GM Technical Assistance to discuss warranty concerns on the aftermarket calibrations. ALL questions and concerns about warranty should be directed to the dealers Fixed Operations Manager (FOM), (Warranty Manager (WM) in Canada). 29. You may call the PQC two hours after submitting the e-mail for authorization to replace the assembly. This will provide them time to receive, review and set up a case on the request. Please be prepared to provide all the usual documentation that is normally required when requesting an assembly authorization from the PQC. Warranty Information - The Dealership Service Management must be involved in any situation that would justify the use of labor operation Z1111. - Notify the Fixed Operations Manager (FOM) (Warranty Manager (WM) in Canada) of the situation. - All claims will have to be routed to the FOM (WM in Canada) for approval. - Please refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 09-00-89-016, Labor Operation Z1111 - Suspected Tampering or Vehicle Modifications for important information. For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table above. Disclaimer Page 7240 5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape. Seat Belt Schematic Icons Seat Belt Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons Page 6168 Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Diagrams Engine Controls Connector End Views Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor Page 4118 20. Extract a portion of the ECT sensor harness wiring and connector from the protective conduit. Cut off the ECT sensor harness connector and wiring. 21. Determine a routing path for the ECT sensor jumper harness wires so that they can be secured TO or WITHIN an existing protective conduit. Note This step is to set up and verify the length of wiring that is required before cutting. 22. Route the ECT sensor jumper wires and then enclose them in their own protective conduit in order to VERIFY the length that is required. 23. Cut the ECT sensor jumper wires to the appropriate length. Note Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splice or connector. 24. Splice the ECT sensor jumper wires to the ORIGINAL ECT HARNESS LOCATION using DuraSeal weatherproof splices. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves in SI. Note Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splice or connector. 25. Splice the ECT sensor jumper wires to the ECT SENSOR HARNESS CONNECTOR using DuraSeal weatherproof splices. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves in SI. 26. Connect the ECT sensor harness connector to the ECT sensor. 27. Secure the ECT sensor jumper wires that are in their own protective conduit TO or WITHIN the existing harness conduit using tie straps. Important You MUST run the engine at the specified RPM and until it reaches normal operating temperature and then allow it to idle as indicated in SI. The engine MUST then be allowed to cool down in order to top off the coolant level as needed. 28. Fill the cooling system to the proper level. Refer to Cooling System Draining and Filling in SI. 29. Pressure test the cooling system. Refer to Cooling System Leak Testing in SI. 30. Use a scan tool to clear any DTCs. Relocating the Engine Coolant Heater Cord Important For reference, the procedure and graphics that are shown are from a Chevrolet Silverado, but are similar for the other vehicles listed above. 1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Ask the customer where they would prefer the extension cord to exit from the engine compartment in order to determine the required extension cord length. 3. Obtain an extension cord with the following features: - 120 volt - 14/3 gauge - 15A capacity - Three prong - Polarized plug and receptacle - Chemical resistant - Grounded terminals - Designed for use in a cold outdoor environment - Outer jacket resistant to deterioration from moisture, abrasion and exposure to sunlight - Maximum length of 2.5-3 m (8-10 ft) 4. Release enough of the clips that retain the engine coolant heater cord to the vehicle to provide the necessary length for repositioning. 5. Apply dielectric grease to the electrical contacts of the heater cord receptacle and the extension cord plug to prevent corrosion. Use GM P/N 12345579 (in Canada, use P/N 10953481) or an equivalent. 6. Connect the heater cord receptacle to the extension cord plug and wipe OFF any excess grease. Page 3358 It is very important to use the correct test adapter when testing for proper terminal contact of fuses and relays in a bussed electrical center (BEC). Use J-35616-35 to test for proper terminal contact. Failure to use J-35616-35 can result in improper diagnosis of the BEC. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Separate the connector halves. 2. Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body. 3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J-38125 , test that the retention force is significantly different between a good terminal and a suspect terminal. Replace the female terminal in question. FLAT WIRE (DOCK AND LOCK) CONNECTORS There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock) connectors on the harness side or the component side. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Remove the component in question. 2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side of the connector as oil from your skin may be a source of contamination as well. 3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other imperfections that could cause poor terminal contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are uniform and free of damage or deformation. 4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the on the flat wire harness connector in order to test the circuit in question. CONTROL MODULE/COMPONENT VOLTAGE AND GROUNDS Poor voltage or ground connections can cause widely varying symptoms. Test all control module voltage supply circuits. Many vehicles have multiple circuits supplying voltage to a control module. Other components in the system may have separate voltage supply circuits that may also need to be tested. Inspect connections at the module/component connectors, fuses, and any intermediate connections between the voltage source and the module/component. A test lamp or a DMM may indicate that voltage is present, but neither tests the ability of the circuit to carry sufficient current. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Power Distribution Schematics. - Test all control module ground and system ground circuits. The control module may have multiple ground circuits. Other components in the system may have separate grounds that may also need to be tested. Inspect grounds for clean and tight connections at the grounding point. Inspect the connections at the component and in splice packs, where applicable. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Ground Distribution Schematics. TEMPERATURE SENSITIVITY - An intermittent condition may occur when a component/connection reaches normal operating temperature. The condition may occur only when the component/connection is cold, or only when the component/connection is hot. - Freeze Frame, Failure Records, Snapshot, or Vehicle Data Recorder data may help with this type of intermittent condition, where applicable. - If the intermittent is related to heat, review the data for a relationship with the following: High ambient temperatures - Underhood/engine generated heat - Circuit generated heat due to a poor connection, or high electrical load - Higher than normal load conditions, towing, etc. - If the intermittent is related to cold, review the data for the following: Low ambient temperatures-In extremely low temperatures, ice may form in a connection or component. Inspect for water intrusion. - The condition only occurs on a cold start. - The condition goes away when the vehicle warms up. - Information from the customer may help to determine if the trouble follows a pattern that is temperature related. - If temperature is suspected of causing an intermittent fault condition, attempt to duplicate the condition. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required. ELECTROMAGNETIC INTERFERENCE (EMI) AND ELECTRICAL NOISE Some electrical components/circuits are sensitive to electromagnetic interference (EMI) or other types of electrical noise. Inspect for the following conditions: A misrouted harness that is too close to high voltage/high current devices such as secondary ignition components, motors, generator etc-These components may induce electrical noise on a circuit that could interfere with normal circuit operation. - Electrical system interference caused by a malfunctioning relay, or a control module driven solenoid or switch-These conditions can cause a sharp electrical surge. Normally, the condition will occur when the malfunctioning component is operating. - Improper installation of non-factory or aftermarket add on accessories such as lights, 2-way radios, amplifiers, electric motors, remote starters, alarm systems, cell phones, etc-These accessories may lead to interference while in use, but do not fail when the accessories are not in use. - Test for an open diode across the A/C compressor clutch and for other open diodes. Some relays may contain a clamping diode. - The generator may be allowing AC noise into the electrical system. INCORRECT CONTROL MODULE - There are only a few situations where reprogramming a control module is appropriate: A new service control module is installed. Page 8323 11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the solder equipment. 12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. 13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to cover the first piece of tape. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE SLEEVES TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit IMPORTANT: Use only dura seal splice sleeves. Other splice sleeves may not protect the splice from moisture or provide a good electrical connection. Use duraseal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. Use duraseal splice sleeves where there is special requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire using duraseal splice sleeves. Page 5853 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. 4. Remove the dress cover by using a flat bladed tool to release the dress cover locking tabs and lift up on the dress cover. 5. Cut the tie wrap that holds the wires to the connector body. Specifications Camshaft: Specifications Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor Bolt ...................................................................................................................................................... ................................................. 12 N.m (106 lb in) Wire Harness Bolt ................................................ ................................................................................................................................ 12 N.m (106 lb in) Camshaft Retainer Bolts Hex Head Bolts .................................................................................................................................... ................................................... 25 N.m (18 lb ft) TORX(R) Head Bolts ............................................ .................................................................................................................................. 15 N.m (11 lb ft) Page 6621 1. Install the CKP sensor. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Install the CKP sensor bolt. Tighten the bolt to 25 N.m (18 lb ft). 3. Connect the electrical connector (2) to the CKP sensor (1). 4. Install the starter. Page 867 4. Slide the dress cover forward and off of the connector. 5. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front and rear of the connector. Page 5797 Page 2156 2. Use a small flat-bladed tool to release the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting the tool in the small recess on the side of the connector and pushing up until the TPA releases from the connector body. The TPA should raise just slightly. Do not try to remove the TPA. IMPORTANT: The TPA on this connector cannot be removed unless the terminals are removed first. The TPA will come out of the connector body, but only slightly. When the TPA is slightly raised the terminals can be removed. Using excessive force to remove the TPA with the terminals still in the connector will damage the connector. 3. Repeat the process for the other side of the connector. 4. Ensure that the TPA is in the proper position to remove the terminals. Page 4364 Page 4767 Page 3967 1. Install the valve rocker arm cover onto the cylinder head. 2. Install new rocker arm cover grommets, if necessary. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 3. Install the rocker arm cover bolts. Tighten the bolts to 12 N.m (106 lb in). 4. Install the PCV hose to the rocker arm cover. Page 8833 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 358 MEASURING FREQUENCY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal. IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM to autorange to an appropriate range. 1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency measured. Measuring Voltage MEASURING VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit. 1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods: - Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. - Turn ON the engine. - Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls. - Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested. 3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The DMM displays the voltage measured at that point. Measuring Voltage Drop MEASURING VOLTAGE DROP NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points. Probing Electrical Connectors PROBING ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS Page 7179 View of the connector when released from the component. View of another type of Micro 64 connector. Page 1028 Behind Left Headlamp Page 6147 If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs SIR/SRS WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS, and the wiring components, such as connectors and terminals. IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system terminals. Use either an SIR/SRS pigtail or a terminated lead from the SIR Repair Kit Tray. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves, in order to repair the SIR/SRS wiring - A special crimping tool - A heat torch - An instruction manual The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides the necessary low resistance contact integrity for these sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors SIR/SRS CONNECTOR REPAIR (PLASTIC BODY AND TERMINAL METAL PIN) The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made with a special plating. This plating provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. Use the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit for repairing SIR/SRS terminals and connectors. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the repair kit. The J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit contains: Various terminated leads for sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) terminal replacement - Various connector positive assurance (CPA) locks for SIR/SRS connectors - Base of steering column pigtail connectors part number 12085514 - Yellow vinyl electrical tape Pigtail repair packs are available for SIR/SRS connectors with eight or less terminals. Only the connector body is available for connectors with more than eight terminals. The terminated leads in the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit can be used to replace damaged terminals when replacing the connector body. SIR/SRS COMPONENT WIRE PIGTAIL REPAIR IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails. A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device, not by a connector. If a wiring pigtail is damaged, you must replace the entire component, with pigtail. The inflatable restraint steering wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component. SIR/SRS WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 355 Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Technician Safety Information Fuel Pressure: Technician Safety Information Relieving Fuel Pressure Caution Caution: Remove the fuel tank cap and relieve the fuel system pressure before servicing the fuel system in order to reduce the risk of personal injury. After you relieve the fuel system pressure, a small amount of fuel may be released when servicing the fuel lines, the fuel injection pump, or the connections. In order to reduce the risk of personal injury, cover the fuel system components with a shop towel before disconnection. This will catch any fuel that may leak out. Place the towel in an approved container when the disconnection is complete. Page 8659 Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested: - Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. - Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a component or to other harnesses. - If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A TEST LAMP TOOLS REQUIRED J 35616-200 Test Light - Probe Kit NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminate even though voltage is present. The J 35616-200 is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair of leads. To properly operate this tool use the following procedures. When testing for voltage: 1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested. When testing for ground: 1. Attach one lead to battery positive voltage. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where ground should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is ground at the point being tested. Using Connector Test Adapters USING CONNECTOR TEST ADAPTERS NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Using Fused Jumper Wires USING FUSED JUMPER WIRES TOOLS REQUIRED J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged. The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested. AFL/ECP Connectors AFL/EPC CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 5850 4. Slide the dress cover forward and off of the connector. 5. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front and rear of the connector. Page 4025 7. Remove the 3 bracket retaining bolts from the frame engine mount. 8. Install a pole jack underneath the oil pan. 9. Insert a block of wood between the oil pan and the pole jack. Page 2909 Ignition Cable: Testing and Inspection Spark Plug Wire Inspection Spark plug wire integrity is vital for proper engine operation. A thorough inspection is necessary to accurately identify conditions that may affect engine operation. Inspect for the following conditions: 1. Correct routing of the spark plug wires - Incorrect routing may cause cross-firing. 2. Any signs of cracks or splits in the wires. 3. Inspect each boot for the following conditions: * Tearing * Piercing * Arcing * Carbon tracking * Corroded terminal If corrosion, carbon tracking or arcing are indicated on a spark plug wire boot or terminal, replace the wire and the component connected to the wire. Page 2291 5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape. Seat Belt Schematic Icons Seat Belt Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons Engine - GM dexos 1 and dexos 2(R) Oil Specifications Engine Oil: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - GM dexos 1 and dexos 2(R) Oil Specifications INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 11-00-90-001 Date: March 14, 2011 Subject: Global Information for GM dexos1(TM) and GM dexos2(TM) Engine Oil Specifications for Spark Ignited and Diesel Engines, Available Licensed Brands, and Service Fill for Adding or Complete Oil Change Models: 2012 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks Excluding All Vehicles Equipped with Duramax(TM) Diesel Engines GM dexos 1(TM) Information Center Website Refer to the following General Motors website for dexos 1(TM) information about the different licensed brands that are currently available: http://www.gmdexos.com GM dexos 1(TM) Engine Oil Trademark and Icons The dexos(TM) specification and trademarks are exclusive to General Motors, LLC. Only those oils displaying the dexos‹›(TM) trademark and icon on the front label meet the demanding performance requirements and stringent quality standards set forth in the dexos‹›(TM) specification. Look on the front label for any of the logos shown above to identify an authorized, licensed dexos 1(TM) engine oil. GM dexos 1(TM) Engine Oil Specification Important General Motors dexos 1(TM) engine oil specification replaces the previous General Motors specifications GM6094M, GM4718M and GM-LL-A-025 for most GM gasoline engines. The oil specified for use in GM passenger cars and trucks, PRIOR to the 2011 model year remains acceptable for those previous vehicles. However, dexos 1(TM) is backward compatible and can be used in those older vehicles. In North America, starting with the 2011 model year, GM introduced dexos 1(TM) certified engine oil as a factory fill and service fill for gasoline engines. The reasons for the new engine oil specification are as follows: - To meet environmental goals such as increasing fuel efficiency and reducing engine emissions. - To promote long engine life. - To minimize the number of engine oil changes in order to help meet the goal of lessening the industry's overall dependence on crude oil. dexos 1(TM) is a GM-developed engine oil specification that has been designed to provide the following benefits: - Further improve fuel economy, to meet future corporate average fuel economy (CAFE) requirements and fuel economy retention by allowing the oil to maintain its fuel economy benefits throughout the life of the oil. - More robust formulations for added engine protection and aeration performance. Page 906 5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape. Seat Belt Schematic Icons Seat Belt Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons Page 2489 2. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 4878 Diagram Information and Instructions Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions Electrical Symbols Page 5533 Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested: - Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. - Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a component or to other harnesses. - If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A TEST LAMP TOOLS REQUIRED J 35616-200 Test Light - Probe Kit NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminate even though voltage is present. The J 35616-200 is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair of leads. To properly operate this tool use the following procedures. When testing for voltage: 1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested. When testing for ground: 1. Attach one lead to battery positive voltage. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where ground should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is ground at the point being tested. Using Connector Test Adapters USING CONNECTOR TEST ADAPTERS NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Using Fused Jumper Wires USING FUSED JUMPER WIRES TOOLS REQUIRED J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged. The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested. AFL/ECP Connectors AFL/EPC CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Restraints - Air Bag Lamp ON/DTC B0092 Set Air Bag Control Module: Customer Interest Restraints - Air Bag Lamp ON/DTC B0092 Set Bulletin No.: 07-09-41-005 Date: July 10, 2007 TECHNICAL Subject: Airbag Light On, Passenger Airbag Status Indicator Reads Off, DTC B0092 Set (Diagnose and Replace SDM, if Necessary) Models: 2007 Chevrolet TrailBlazer 2007 GMC Envoy 2007 HUMMER H3 without Roof Side Inflatable Restraint (RPO ASF) Condition Some customers may comment that the airbag light is illuminated and the passenger airbag status indicator reads off even though a occupant is in the seat. Upon investigation, the technician may find communication error DTC B0092 set in the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM). Correction Using the Tech 2(R), request module ID information to determine the part number of the SDM. If the SDM part number is 25833651 (Envoy/TrailBlazer) or 25833286 (H3), replace the SDM before proceeding with DTC B0092 diagnosis. If the part number of the SDM is other than those listed above, follow diagnostic instructions published in SI. Parts Information Warranty Information Page 2456 4. Once the front 2 locks are unlocked, lift the front of the dress cover and pull it forward. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the small slot on the TPA and pushing down until the TPA releases. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to angle or rock the J 38125-21 tool when inserting it into the connector or the tool may break. Insert the J 38125-21 (GM P/N 15381651-2) tool into the round canal between the terminals cavities at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to repair Micro 64 connector terminals. The Micro 64 connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-64 (M jaw) was developed to crimp Micro 64 terminals. The J 38125-64 crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. The J 38125-64 crimping tool is also designed to crimp both the wire and the insulation at the same time. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro 64 terminals. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. 1. Cut the wire as close to the damaged terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. Page 5676 Release the tabs that are holding the wiredress cover to the connector body. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the slots on both ends of the connector body. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. J 38125-216 can also be used to remove the nose piece. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by lifting the terminal retaining tabs on the inside of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 2026 9. The illustration shows a cutaway view of the connector to aid the technician in releasing the terminal retainer. 10. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Terminal Position Assurance Locks TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Tyco/Amp Connectors (CM 42-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (CM 42-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the connector body and pull the CPA out. The CPA is on the wire harness side of connector. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 6886 View of connector in released position. 4. Disconnect the connector from the component. 5. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Release the rear lower half of the wiredress cover. Page 8044 7. The illustration above identifies the entry canal where the terminal release tool will be inserted, and the terminal cavity. - Terminal (1) - Entry Canal (2) 8. Insert the J-38125-553 (15315247) tool into the entry canal and pry up on the terminal retainer. The terminal retainer is a small plastic piece on the top of the terminal. The terminal retainer must be held up while the terminal is pulled out of the connector. Page 8473 Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Crankshaft Position System Variation Learn Crankshaft Position System Variation Learn 1. Install a scan tool. 2. Monitor the engine control module (ECM) for DTCs with a scan tool. If other DTCs are set, except DTC P0315, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle in Vehicle DTC Information for the applicable DTC that set. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Descriptions 3. Select the crankshaft position (CKP) variation learn procedure with a scan tool. 4. The scan tool instructs you to perform the following: 1. Accelerate to wide open throttle (WOT). 2. Release throttle when fuel cut-off occurs. 3. Observe fuel cut-off for applicable engine. 4. Engine should not accelerate beyond calibrated RPM value. 5. Release throttle immediately if value is exceeded. 6. Block drive wheels. 7. Set parking brake. 8. DO NOT apply brake pedal. 9. Cycle ignition from OFF to ON. 10. Apply and hold brake pedal. 11. Start and idle engine. 12. Turn A/C OFF. 13. Vehicle must remain in Park or Neutral. 14. The scan tool monitors certain component signals to determine if all the conditions are met to continue with the procedure. The scan tool only displays the condition that inhibits the procedure. The scan tool monitors the following components: * CKP sensors activity-If there is a CKP sensor condition, refer to the applicable DTC that set. * Camshaft position (CMP) sensor activity-If there is a CMP sensor condition, refer to the applicable DTC that set. * Engine coolant temperature (ECT)-If the ECT is not warm enough, idle the engine until the engine coolant temperature reaches the correct temperature. 5. Enable the CKP system variation learn procedure with a scan tool. Important: While the learn procedure is in progress, release the throttle immediately when the engine starts to decelerate. The engine control is returned to the operator and the engine responds to throttle position after the learn procedure is complete. 6. Accelerate to WOT. 7. Release when the fuel cut-off occurs. 8. Test in progress 9. The scan tool displays Learn Status: Learned this ignition. If the scan tool indicates that DTC P0315 ran and passed, the CKP variation learn procedure is complete. If the scan tool indicates DTC P0315 failed or did not run, refer to DTC P0315. If any other DTCs set, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle in Vehicle DTC Information for the applicable DTC that set. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Descriptions See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/P Code Charts/P0315 10. Turn OFF the ignition for 30 seconds after the learn procedure is completed successfully. 11. The CKP system variation learn procedure is also required when the following service procedures have been performed, regardless of whether DTC P0315 is set: * A CKP sensor replacement * An engine replacement * A ECM replacement * A harmonic balancer replacement * A crankshaft replacement * Any engine repairs which disturb the CKP sensor relationship Page 706 - Most Molex connectors will have the Molex logo on the dresscover of the connector. In some cases the connectors may have MX followed by another letter. The third letter indicates where the connector was made. A connector with MXD is a Molex connector made in Detroit. Sumitomo has a unique symbol on their connector and possibly a part number. The symbol is similar to that of a diamond lying on its side, similar to that shown. The logo could appear anywhere but the most common place is at the wire side of the housing. Tyco/AMP has many different and unique connector designs. Some may or may not have identifiable marks on them. Page 6384 If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the DuraSeal splice sleeves. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: - Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. - Do not use the crimp and DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 to crimp DuraSeal splice sleeve. In order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 4316 15. Remove the water pump bolts. 16. Remove the water pump and gaskets. 17. Discard the water pump gaskets. Installation Procedure Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. Important: All gasket surfaces are to be free of oil or other foreign material during assembly. 1. Install the water pump and NEW gaskets. 2. Install the water pump bolts. 1. On the initial pass, tighten the bolts to 15 N.m (11 lb ft). 2. On the final pass, tighten the bolts to 30 N.m (22 lb ft). 3. Install the auxiliary heater inlet and outlet hose/pipe nut. Page 4669 If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the DuraSeal splice sleeves. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: - Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. - Do not use the crimp and DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 to crimp DuraSeal splice sleeve. In order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 899 If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs SIR/SRS WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS, and the wiring components, such as connectors and terminals. IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system terminals. Use either an SIR/SRS pigtail or a terminated lead from the SIR Repair Kit Tray. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves, in order to repair the SIR/SRS wiring - A special crimping tool - A heat torch - An instruction manual The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides the necessary low resistance contact integrity for these sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors SIR/SRS CONNECTOR REPAIR (PLASTIC BODY AND TERMINAL METAL PIN) The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made with a special plating. This plating provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. Use the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit for repairing SIR/SRS terminals and connectors. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the repair kit. The J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit contains: Various terminated leads for sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) terminal replacement - Various connector positive assurance (CPA) locks for SIR/SRS connectors - Base of steering column pigtail connectors part number 12085514 - Yellow vinyl electrical tape Pigtail repair packs are available for SIR/SRS connectors with eight or less terminals. Only the connector body is available for connectors with more than eight terminals. The terminated leads in the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit can be used to replace damaged terminals when replacing the connector body. SIR/SRS COMPONENT WIRE PIGTAIL REPAIR IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails. A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device, not by a connector. If a wiring pigtail is damaged, you must replace the entire component, with pigtail. The inflatable restraint steering wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component. SIR/SRS WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 8699 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Kostal Connectors KOSTAL CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 731 4. Slide the dress cover forward and off of the connector. 5. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front and rear of the connector. Page 5306 6. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs located on the opposite side of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover at the connector end and pry up. 7. Remove the dress cover. 8. Cut the tie wrap on the wire bundle. 9. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting a small flat-bladed tool into the small slot in the end of the slider and pushing on the TPA until it comes out of the connector. When the TPA exits the opposite side of the connector, gasp the TPA and pull it completely out of the connector. 10. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 8643 Page 8562 4. Slide the dress cover forward and off of the connector. 5. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front and rear of the connector. Page 4077 Engine Oil: Service and Repair Engine Oil and Oil Filter Replacement Removal Procedure Important: In order to completely drain the oil from the oil pan internal baffling, the bottom of the oil pan must be level during the oil drain procedure. 1. Open the hood. 2. Remove the oil fill cap. 3. Raise and suitably support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 4. Place a oil drain pan under the oil pan drain plug. 5. Remove the oil pan drain plug. 6. Drain the engine oil. 7. Remove the oil filter from the oil pan. 8. Inspect the old oil filter to ensure that the filter seal is not left on the oil pan. Page 6047 Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Heated Oxygen Sensor Replacement - Bank 2 Sensor 2 Heated Oxygen Sensor Replacement - Bank 2 Sensor 2 Removal Procedure 1. Raise and suitably support the vehicle. Refer to vehicle lifting. Notice: Refer to Heated Oxygen and Oxygen Sensor Notice. 2. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) retainer. 3. Disconnect the heated oxygen sensor (HO2S) electrical connector (1). Notice: Refer to Excessive Force and Oxygen Sensor Notice. 4. Remove the HO2S (2). Installation Procedure Important: A special anti-seize compound is used on the HO2S threads. The compound consists of liquid graphite and glass beads. The graphite tends to burn away, but the glass beads remain, making the sensor easier to remove. New, or service replacement sensors already have the compound applied to the threads. If the sensor is removed from an exhaust component and if for any reason the sensor is to be reinstalled, the threads must have anti-seize compound applied before the reinstallation. Page 8162 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) and slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. Page 9048 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the TPA. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the nose piece. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. Page 8729 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Start in the middle and gradually move the heat barrel to the open ends of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Heated Oxygen Sensor Wiring Repairs HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being obstructed. If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. - Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks, etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire. - Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance. - To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector. Locations Knock Sensor: Locations Engine Controls Component Views Lower Left Side of Engine - Rear 1 - G108 2 - Knock Sensor (KS) 1 - Left 3 - Engine 4 - G107 5 - Engine Harness Lower Right Side of the Engine - Rear Page 7198 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully raise the TPA on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA cannot be removed from the connector while there are terminals present in the connector body. View of the TPA when removed from the connector body. 4. Use the J 38125-12A tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the left side of the terminal release cavity as shown in the graphic. Use the tool to move the terminal release to the right with a gentle prying motion. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 1177 Discharge Air Temperature Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair Air Temperature Sensor Replacement - Lower Right Side Air Temperature Sensor Replacement - Lower Right Side Removal Procedure 1. Remove the passenger side closeout panel. 2. Remove the I/P lower closeout panel. 3. Disconnect the electrical connector (3) from the air temperature sensor-lower right (2). 4. Remove the air temperature sensor-lower right (2). Installation Procedure 1. Install the air temperature sensor-lower right (2). 2. Connect the electrical connector (3) to the air temperature sensor-lower right (2). 3. Install the I/P lower closeout panel. 4. Install the passenger side closeout panel. TPMS System - Service And Re-Learning Sensor IDs Tire Pressure Module: Technical Service Bulletins TPMS System - Service And Re-Learning Sensor IDs INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 10-03-16-001 Date: July 19, 2010 Subject: TPMS System Service and Re-Learning Sensor IDs Models: 2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2 2009 and Prior HUMMER H3 2010 and Prior Saturn Models 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X with Wheel-Mounted Tire Pressure Sensors In the event that the spare tire, which is normally not equipped with a tire pressure monitor (TPM) sensor, is installed in place of one of the road tires and the vehicle is driven above 40 km/h (25 mph) for 20 minutes or more, the TPM indicator icon on the instrument panel cluster (IPC) will flash for approximately one minute and then remain on steady each time the ignition is turned ON, indicating a diagnostic trouble code (DTC) has been set. The driver information center (DIC), if equipped, will also display a SERVICE TIRE MONITOR type message. When the road tire is repaired and reinstalled in the original location, the TPM indicator icon illumination and DIC message may remain displayed until the DTC is cleared. To ensure that the TPM indicator and the DIC message are cleared after service, it is necessary to clear any TPM DTCs using a scan tool. If a scan tool is unavailable, performing the TPM relearn procedure using a TPM diagnostic tool will provide the same results. It is advised to perform the relearn procedure away from other vehicles to prevent picking up a stray sensor signal. If one or more of the TPM sensors are missing or damaged and have been replaced, then the relearn procedure must be performed. Disclaimer Page 6300 Checking Aftermarket Accessories CHECKING AFTERMARKET ACCESSORIES Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits: - CAUTION: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol. - NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice. OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol. Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the cause of the problems. Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include: Power feeds connected to points other than the battery - Antenna location - Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring - Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line - Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories. Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions INDUCING INTERMITTENT FAULT CONDITIONS TOOLS REQUIRED J 25070 Heat Gun Many intermittent open or shorted circuits are affected by harness/connector movement that is caused by vibration, engine torque, bumps/rough pavement, etc. In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness if the malfunction appears to be Page 7434 8. If replacement of the ECM/TCM bracket is required, remove the TCM. 9. Remove the ECM/TCM bracket retaining bolts (2). 10 Remove the ECM/TCM bracket (1) from the vehicle frame. Installation Procedure 1. If the ECM/TCM bracket (1) was previously removed, install the ECM/TCM bracket (1) to the vehicle frame. 2. Install the ECM/TCM bracket retaining bolts (2). Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 3. Tighten the ECM/TCM bracket bolts. Tighten the bolts to 10 N.m (89 lb in). 4. Install the TCM. Page 4968 Open the harness by removing any tape. 2. Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. 3. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 4. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent american wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 5. Slide a section of high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing down the length of wire to be spliced. Ensure that the shrink tubing will not interfere with the splice procedure. 6. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 7. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. 8. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 9. Insert the wire into the DuraSeal splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 10. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Page 1837 Page 6457 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. JST Connectors JST CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, remove the connector from the component. Service and Repair Muffler: Service and Repair Muffler Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Raise and suitably support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. Important: Do not reuse any component of the exhaust system that is corroded or damaged. Important: When replacing the muffler in a vehicle with the LL8 engine, the resonator and tailpipe must also be ordered. The 2 pieces may be attached with a clamp. 2. Inspect the exhaust system components to determine if they can be reused. 3. Remove the frame brace. Refer to Frame Brace Replacement (TrailBlazer EXT, Envoy XL) Frame Brace Replacement (TrailBlazer, Envoy, Bravada). 4. Remove the nuts that secure the muffler to the catalytic converter pipe. 5. Separate the muffler and the tail pipe assembly from the hanger insulators. 6. Lower the muffler and tail pipe assembly. 7. Suitably support the exhaust system. 8. Cut the exhaust pipe at the dashed line (1). 9. Remove the muffler from the tail pipe. Installation Procedure Page 6138 2. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully push the terminal position assurance (TPA) towards the face of the connector on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA is fragile and may break if not done carefully. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. 3. Use the J 38125-215 tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 371 difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Bosch Connectors (ECM) BOSCH CONNECTORS (ECM) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the assist lever on the top of the connector. Move the assist lever to the forward position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 6898 - In some cases Delphi will actually be printed on the connector. If Delphi is not printed on the connector, look for PED. In both cases there is no specific orientation for Delphi or PED and they can appear anywhere on the connector. - FCI connectors may have the FCI logo on their connectors. The logo is the letters FCI with an "A" above it. - JAE connector have JAE in small letters on their connectors. Page 8819 Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. FCI Connectors FCI CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 3449 Fuse Block - Rear C1 (Pin E8 To F12) Page 506 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) and slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. Page 3035 3. Radiator outlet hose (lower hose) to engine (3). (Shown as viewed from below.) 4. Radiator outlet hose (lower hose) to radiator (4). (Shown as viewed from below.) 5. Heater inlet hose to engine (5). Page 6929 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry one side of the nose piece up to the pre-stage position. When the nose piece is in the pre-staged position, the nose piece will be raised above the connector body the length of the step in the nose piece. 7. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry the other side of the piece to the pre-stage position. If the nose piece is higher than the first step in the nose piece, gently push down on the nose piece until it meets with resistance from the connector body, you should feel the nose piece click into position. Page 9067 9. The illustration shows a cutaway view of the connector to aid the technician in releasing the terminal retainer. 10. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Terminal Position Assurance Locks TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Tyco/Amp Connectors (CM 42-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (CM 42-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the connector body and pull the CPA out. The CPA is on the wire harness side of connector. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 8056 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert a small flat-blade tool in the slot below the front loaded terminal position assurance (TPA) and pry up. 3. Remove the TPA by pulling it out of the connector. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-553 (GM P/N 15315247) on a slight upward angle into the cavity below the terminal to be removed. Ensure that the pointed on the end of the tool is facing the bottom of the terminal and it stays in contact with the terminal until it stops on the plastic terminal retainer. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 1300 Page 8724 2. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully push the terminal position assurance (TPA) towards the face of the connector on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA is fragile and may break if not done carefully. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. 3. Use the J 38125-215 tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Brakes - Squeak Noise On Brake Pedal Application Brake Fluid: Customer Interest Brakes - Squeak Noise On Brake Pedal Application TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 08-05-22-002C Date: April 07, 2009 Subject: Squeak Noise On Brake Apply (Remove Brake Fluid from Master Cylinder and Refill) Models: 2004-2007 Buick Rainier 2008 Buick Enclave 2004-2008 Chevrolet Colorado, TrailBlazer, TrailBlazer EXT, TrailBlazer SS 2008 Chevrolet Malibu 2009 Chevrolet Malibu (VIN position 11, 4 Orion MI. build with Build Date Prior to April 20, 2009) 2004-2008 GMC Canyon, Envoy, Envoy XL, Envoy XUV 2007-2008 GMC Acadia 2008 Pontiac G6 2009 Pontiac G6 (VIN position 11, 4 Orion MI. build with Build Date Prior to April 20, 2009) 2007-2008 Saturn OUTLOOK 2008 Saturn AURA 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 08-05-22-002B (Section 05 - Brakes). Condition Some customers may comment on a squeak noise when the brake pedal is applied or when released. This noise is normally heard when the brake pedal is slowly applied with the engine on or off, but can occur when the brake pedal is released. The noise may be isolated to the master cylinder area. Correction To correct this concern, remove as much of the old brake fluid from the master cylinder as possible and refill with a new DOT 3 brake fluid, P/N 88862806 (in Canada, use P/N 88862807). Start the vehicle and fully cycle the brake pedal until the noise diminishes to allow the new fluid to enter the system. Parts Information Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table above. Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models) Page 4611 - Most Molex connectors will have the Molex logo on the dresscover of the connector. In some cases the connectors may have MX followed by another letter. The third letter indicates where the connector was made. A connector with MXD is a Molex connector made in Detroit. Sumitomo has a unique symbol on their connector and possibly a part number. The symbol is similar to that of a diamond lying on its side, similar to that shown. The logo could appear anywhere but the most common place is at the wire side of the housing. Tyco/AMP has many different and unique connector designs. Some may or may not have identifiable marks on them. Page 6957 If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs SIR/SRS WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS, and the wiring components, such as connectors and terminals. IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system terminals. Use either an SIR/SRS pigtail or a terminated lead from the SIR Repair Kit Tray. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves, in order to repair the SIR/SRS wiring - A special crimping tool - A heat torch - An instruction manual The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides the necessary low resistance contact integrity for these sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors SIR/SRS CONNECTOR REPAIR (PLASTIC BODY AND TERMINAL METAL PIN) The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made with a special plating. This plating provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. Use the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit for repairing SIR/SRS terminals and connectors. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the repair kit. The J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit contains: Various terminated leads for sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) terminal replacement - Various connector positive assurance (CPA) locks for SIR/SRS connectors - Base of steering column pigtail connectors part number 12085514 - Yellow vinyl electrical tape Pigtail repair packs are available for SIR/SRS connectors with eight or less terminals. Only the connector body is available for connectors with more than eight terminals. The terminated leads in the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit can be used to replace damaged terminals when replacing the connector body. SIR/SRS COMPONENT WIRE PIGTAIL REPAIR IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails. A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device, not by a connector. If a wiring pigtail is damaged, you must replace the entire component, with pigtail. The inflatable restraint steering wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component. SIR/SRS WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 8976 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the DuraSeal splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of a connector. CPAs are used in all SIR System connectors and also in some connectors of other systems. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals of a connection. TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE CLIPS IMPORTANT: When making a splice in an area that may be exposed to moisture use a crimp and seal splice sleeve instead of a Splice Clip. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. Page 1557 Page 2159 View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. View of the release tool being used for the smaller terminals. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (2-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 7163 Release the tabs that are holding the wiredress cover to the connector body. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the slots on both ends of the connector body. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. J 38125-216 can also be used to remove the nose piece. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by lifting the terminal retaining tabs on the inside of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 7594 Page 1451 - Most Molex connectors will have the Molex logo on the dresscover of the connector. In some cases the connectors may have MX followed by another letter. The third letter indicates where the connector was made. A connector with MXD is a Molex connector made in Detroit. Sumitomo has a unique symbol on their connector and possibly a part number. The symbol is similar to that of a diamond lying on its side, similar to that shown. The logo could appear anywhere but the most common place is at the wire side of the housing. Tyco/AMP has many different and unique connector designs. Some may or may not have identifiable marks on them. Page 5341 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. 4. Remove the dress cover by using a flat bladed tool to release the dress cover locking tabs and lift up on the dress cover. 5. Cut the tie wrap that holds the wires to the connector body. Page 485 6. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs located on the opposite side of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover at the connector end and pry up. 7. Remove the dress cover. 8. Cut the tie wrap on the wire bundle. 9. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting a small flat-bladed tool into the small slot in the end of the slider and pushing on the TPA until it comes out of the connector. When the TPA exits the opposite side of the connector, gasp the TPA and pull it completely out of the connector. 10. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 3474 7. Remove the junction block bracket retaining bolts (1) and remove the junction block bracket from the vehicle. INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 1. NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice. Position the junction block bracket and install the bolts (1). Tighten the junction block bracket bolts to 6 N.m (53 lb in). 2. Align the wiring harnesses and install the fuse relay center. Page 6907 The first connector design of the Micro-Pack 100W (1) has a white connector interface that holds the terminals. The second design of the Micro-Pack 100W (2) has a gray interface to hold the terminals. Also, the first design has terminal cavities that are further apart (3 mm centerline) and offset from the other row of terminal cavities in the connector. The second design has terminals cavities that are closer together (2.54 mm centerline) and aligned vertically. One other way to identify the second design is the thin strip of material that runs along the outside of the cavities. IMPORTANT: There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W terminals which are very similar. Ensure that you have the correct terminal before crimping the new terminal to the wire. The first design connector uses the longer terminal (1) that has a raised area in front of the recess in the terminal. The second design connector uses the shorter terminal without the raised area. Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro-Pack 100W connectors. Some Micro-Pack 100W connector disassembly procedures will vary. Use this procedure as a guide. 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 8285 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Kostal Connectors KOSTAL CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 8961 Release the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the blue locking tabs on both ends of the connector. Gently slide the TPA up to the released position on both ends. 6. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-13A (GM P/N 12031876-1) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. Page 2209 - A control module from another vehicle is installed. - Revised software/calibration files have been released for this vehicle. - IMPORTANT: DO NOT re-program the control module with the SAME software/calibration files that are already present in the control module. This is not an effective repair for any type of concern. Verify that the control module contains the correct software/calibration. If incorrect programming is found, reprogram the control module with the most current software/calibration. Refer to Control Module References for replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Testing for Short to Ground TESTING FOR SHORT TO GROUND NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 4. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit. With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is a short to ground in the circuit. Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2. Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). - When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. - If the DMM does not display voltage 4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is shorted. Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A DIGITAL MULTIMETER NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the powertrain control module (PCM), should only be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200 Digital Multimeter (DMM). The J 39200 instruction manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminage even though voltage is present. The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity. IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading. Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the measurement. Page 7682 If a wire is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm, etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except coaxial. - Do not use the DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent American wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 1050 Seat Position Sensor - Horizontal (w/Memory) Page 4954 3. Ensure that the terminal release tang access panel is in the correct location to access the terminals. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) into the terminal release tang access slot located behind the access panel of the connector and press down on the terminal while carefully pulling the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Tyco/AMP Connectors (0.25 Cap) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (025 CAP) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component by pressing down on the connector position assurance (CPA). Page 4955 2. Use a small flat-bladed tool to release the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting the tool in the small recess on the side of the connector and pushing up until the TPA releases from the connector body. The TPA should raise just slightly. Do not try to remove the TPA. IMPORTANT: The TPA on this connector cannot be removed unless the terminals are removed first. The TPA will come out of the connector body, but only slightly. When the TPA is slightly raised the terminals can be removed. Using excessive force to remove the TPA with the terminals still in the connector will damage the connector. 3. Repeat the process for the other side of the connector. 4. Ensure that the TPA is in the proper position to remove the terminals. Page 1500 View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. 4. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers CIRCUIT PROTECTION - CIRCUIT BREAKERS A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types of circuit Page 883 3. Ensure that the terminal release tang access panel is in the correct location to access the terminals. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) into the terminal release tang access slot located behind the access panel of the connector and press down on the terminal while carefully pulling the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Tyco/AMP Connectors (0.25 Cap) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (025 CAP) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component by pressing down on the connector position assurance (CPA). Page 7413 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link). - The wire insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. 5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold them between thumb and forefinger. 7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place. - Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction. - Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip. 8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool closes.Ensure that no strands of wire are cut. 10. Crimp the splice on each end (2). Page 1175 Discharge Air Temperature Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair Air Temperature Sensor Replacement - Upper Left Side Air Temperature Sensor Replacement - Upper Left Side Removal Procedure 1. Remove the radio. 2. Remove the HVAC control module. 3. Remove the air temperature sensor. 4. Disconnect the electrical connector (2) from the upper air temperature sensor (1). Installation Procedure 1. Install the upper air temperature sensor (1) to the air duct (2). 2. Connect the electrical connector (2) to the upper air temperature sensor (1). 3. Install the upper air temperature sensor. 4. Install the HVAC control module. 5. Install the radio. Page 7197 2. Locate the two indents of the terminal position assurance (TPA) located on the bottom of the connector body. Page 6887 Release the tabs that are holding the wiredress cover to the connector body. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the slots on both ends of the connector body. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. J 38125-216 can also be used to remove the nose piece. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by lifting the terminal retaining tabs on the inside of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 6002 2. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 7084 6. Gently pry the plastic terminal retainer down and carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (16-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, pull the two connector halves apart. Page 2606 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully raise the TPA on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA cannot be removed from the connector while there are terminals present in the connector body. View of the TPA when removed from the connector body. 4. Use the J 38125-12A tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the left side of the terminal release cavity as shown in the graphic. Use the tool to move the terminal release to the right with a gentle prying motion. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 8807 4. Once the front 2 locks are unlocked, lift the front of the dress cover and pull it forward. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the small slot on the TPA and pushing down until the TPA releases. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to angle or rock the J 38125-21 tool when inserting it into the connector or the tool may break. Insert the J 38125-21 (GM P/N 15381651-2) tool into the round canal between the terminals cavities at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to repair Micro 64 connector terminals. The Micro 64 connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-64 (M jaw) was developed to crimp Micro 64 terminals. The J 38125-64 crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. The J 38125-64 crimping tool is also designed to crimp both the wire and the insulation at the same time. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro 64 terminals. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. 1. Cut the wire as close to the damaged terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. Page 8791 difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Bosch Connectors (ECM) BOSCH CONNECTORS (ECM) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the assist lever on the top of the connector. Move the assist lever to the forward position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 5859 7. The illustration above identifies the entry canal where the terminal release tool will be inserted, and the terminal cavity. - Terminal (1) - Entry Canal (2) 8. Insert the J-38125-553 (15315247) tool into the entry canal and pry up on the terminal retainer. The terminal retainer is a small plastic piece on the top of the terminal. The terminal retainer must be held up while the terminal is pulled out of the connector. Page 2267 6. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by pressing on the tang. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (SENSOR) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) tool into the cavity on the lower right hand face of the connector until the terminal release tang access panel slides over. Page 7586 7. Data link connector terminals 2 and 5 provide the connection to the class 2 serial data circuit and the signal ground circuit respectively. 9. A poor connection at splice pack SP205 will cause this condition but will not set a DTC. 10. An open in the class 2 serial data circuit between the DLC and splice pack SP205 will prevent the scan tool from communicating with any module on the class 2 network. This condition will not set a DTC. Page 8918 - Yazaki has a wedge or arrow shape, similar to that shown. Delphi Connectors (Micro .64) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro 64 connectors. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. The lever lock may be located on the top or sides of the wire dress cover. Page 930 For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 1086 Brake Booster Vacuum Sensor: Service and Repair Power Brake Booster Vacuum Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Disconnect the electrical connector from the brake booster vacuum sensor. 2. Remove the brake booster vacuum sensor (1) from the vacuum brake booster. 3. Remove the brake booster vacuum sensor grommet (2) from the vacuum brake booster. Installation Procedure 1. Install the brake booster vacuum sensor grommet (2) to the vacuum brake booster. 2. Install the brake booster vacuum sensor (1) to the vacuum brake booster. 3. Connect the electrical connector to the brake booster vacuum sensor. Page 1703 IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals. Front probe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the connector. IMPORTANT: When probing female 0.64 terminals, it is important to use the correct adapter. There have been some revisions to the test adapter for 0.64 terminals. The proper adapter for 0.64 terminals is the J 35616-64B which has a gold terminal and a black wire between the base and tip. Failure to use the proper test adapter may result in damage to the terminal being tested and improper diagnosis. NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Page 6844 * Inspect for evidence of improper arcing. - Measure the gap between the center electrode (4) and the side electrode (3). - Inspect for the correct spark plug torque. - Inspect for signs of tracking that occurred near the insulator tip instead of the center electrode (4). - Inspect for a broken or worn side electrode (3). - Inspect for a broken, worn, or loose center electrode (4) by shaking the spark plug. * A rattling sound indicates internal damage. * A looses center electrode (4) reduces the spark intensity. - Inspect for bridged electrodes (3,4). Deposits on the electrodes (3,4) reduce or eliminates the gap. - Inspect for worn or missing platinum pads on the electrodes (3,4), if equipped. - Inspect for excessive fouling. * Inspect the spark plug recess area of the cylinder head for debris. Dirty or damaged threads can cause the spark plug not to seat correctly during installation. Visual Inspection * Normal operation - Brown to grayish-tan with small amounts of white powdery deposits are normal combustion by-products from fuels with additives. * Carbon fouled - Dry, fluffy black carbon, or soot caused by the following conditions: - Rich fuel mixtures * Leaking fuel injectors * Excessive fuel pressure * Restricted air filter element * Incorrect combustion - Reduced ignition system voltage output * Weak ignition coils * Worn ignition wires * Incorrect spark plug gap - Excessive idling or slow speeds under light loads can keep spark plug temperatures so low that normal combustion deposits may not burn off. * Deposit fouling - Oil, coolant, or additives that include substances such as silicone, very white coating, reduces the spark plug intensity. Most powdery deposits will not affect spark plug intensity unless they form into a glazing over the electrode. Page 8920 View of the connector when released from the component. View of another type of Micro 64 connector. Page 5596 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert a small flat-blade tool in the slot below the front loaded terminal position assurance (TPA) and pry up. 3. Remove the TPA by pulling it out of the connector. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-553 (GM P/N 15315247) on a slight upward angle into the cavity below the terminal to be removed. Ensure that the pointed on the end of the tool is facing the bottom of the terminal and it stays in contact with the terminal until it stops on the plastic terminal retainer. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 8799 - Kostel - Molex - Sumitomo - Tyco/AMP - Yazaki Identifying the manufacturer of a connector is often difficult. When trying to determine the manufacturer of a connector, look for specific identifying marks that are unique to that connector supplier. Most of these identify marks are hard to find or see. Check the connector carefully and refer to the information below for pictures and descriptions of connector identification markings. - Most of AFLs connectors have EPC on their connector body. Some of the smaller connectors will not have any markings on them. - In some cases Bosch will actually be printed on the connector. If Bosch does not appear on the connector, look for the Bosch logo. The Bosch logo is a circle with a blunted arrow inside. This logo can appear anywhere on the connector and is often very small. Page 908 Page 7168 IMPORTANT: Ensure that the dress cover and connector body are both in the released position before reassembling. Failure to do so may cause damage to the connector and component. Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (0.64) BOSCH CONNECTORS (0.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While pressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock until the lever is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Pull the rubber boot that covers the wires back to expose the end of the connector dress cover. 4. Place the connector locking lever in the center of the connector. 5. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs that are on the wire end of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover and connector body and pry up. Page 9017 3. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. View showing depressing of the lever lock release tab. Page 4027 13. Remove the engine mount with the upper engine mount bracket as an assembly. 14. Separate the engine mount from the upper engine mount bracket. 15. Remove the engine mount bracket spacer if damaged. Installation Procedure Page 1239 Turn Signal/Multifunction Switch C2 Page 576 Page 6028 5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape. Seat Belt Schematic Icons Seat Belt Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons Page 8816 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) and slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. Page 5355 2. Use a small flat-bladed tool to release the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting the tool in the small recess on the side of the connector and pushing up until the TPA releases from the connector body. The TPA should raise just slightly. Do not try to remove the TPA. IMPORTANT: The TPA on this connector cannot be removed unless the terminals are removed first. The TPA will come out of the connector body, but only slightly. When the TPA is slightly raised the terminals can be removed. Using excessive force to remove the TPA with the terminals still in the connector will damage the connector. 3. Repeat the process for the other side of the connector. 4. Ensure that the TPA is in the proper position to remove the terminals. Page 4860 If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs SIR/SRS WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS, and the wiring components, such as connectors and terminals. IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system terminals. Use either an SIR/SRS pigtail or a terminated lead from the SIR Repair Kit Tray. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves, in order to repair the SIR/SRS wiring - A special crimping tool - A heat torch - An instruction manual The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides the necessary low resistance contact integrity for these sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors SIR/SRS CONNECTOR REPAIR (PLASTIC BODY AND TERMINAL METAL PIN) The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made with a special plating. This plating provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. Use the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit for repairing SIR/SRS terminals and connectors. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the repair kit. The J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit contains: Various terminated leads for sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) terminal replacement - Various connector positive assurance (CPA) locks for SIR/SRS connectors - Base of steering column pigtail connectors part number 12085514 - Yellow vinyl electrical tape Pigtail repair packs are available for SIR/SRS connectors with eight or less terminals. Only the connector body is available for connectors with more than eight terminals. The terminated leads in the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit can be used to replace damaged terminals when replacing the connector body. SIR/SRS COMPONENT WIRE PIGTAIL REPAIR IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails. A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device, not by a connector. If a wiring pigtail is damaged, you must replace the entire component, with pigtail. The inflatable restraint steering wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component. SIR/SRS WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 6155 US English/Metric Conversion US English/Metric Conversion Page 4004 Drive Belt: Service and Repair Drive Belt Replacement - Air Conditioning Drive Belt Replacement - Air Conditioning Removal Procedure 1. Remove the accessory drive belt. Refer to Drive Belt Replacement - Accessory. 2. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 3. Install a ratchet into the square opening of the air conditioning (A/C) belt tensioner. 4. Rotate the A/C belt tensioner clockwise in order to relieve tension on the belt. 5. Remove the A/C belt from the pulleys. 6. Slowly release the tension on the A/C belt tensioner. 7. Remove the ratchet from the A/C belt tensioner. 8. Clean and inspect the belt surfaces of all the pulleys. Installation Procedure 1. Install the A/C belt around the crankshaft balancer. 2. Install a ratchet into the square opening of the A/C drive belt tensioner. 3. Rotate the A/C belt tensioner clockwise in order to relieve tension on the belt. 4. Install the A/C belt over the idler pulley. 5. Install the A/C belt around the A/C compressor pulley. 6. Slowly release the tension on the A/C belt tensioner. 7. Remove the ratchet from the A/C belt tensioner. 8. Inspect the A/C belt for proper installation and alignment. 9. Lower the vehicle. 10. Install the accessory drive belt. Refer to Drive Belt Replacement - Accessory. Page 1602 TERMINAL REMOVAL Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors. 1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA) device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1). 3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 4. Gently pull the cable and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector. 5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal, refer to Terminal Repair. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3. Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector. REINSTALLING TERMINAL 1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly, refer to Wiring Repairs. 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3. Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) DELPHI CONNECTORS (WEATHER PACK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 4723 Disclaimer Page 4885 Page 4745 Radiator: Service and Repair Radiator Vent Inlet Hose Replacement Radiator Vent Inlet Hose Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Partially drain the cooling system. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System (LL8) Draining and Filling Cooling System (LH6, LS2). 2. Remove the vent inlet hose from the radiator. 3. Remove the vent inlet hose from the surge tank. Installation Procedure 1. Install the vent inlet hose to the surge tank. 2. Install the vent inlet hose to the radiator. 3. Fill the cooling system. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System (LL8) Draining and Filling Cooling System (LH6, LS2). Page 242 4. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the rear of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. 5. Once the locking tabs are unlocked, slide the inner connector out of the rear of the connector housing. Page 5485 View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. 4. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers CIRCUIT PROTECTION - CIRCUIT BREAKERS A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types of circuit Page 8719 5. While pushing the terminal forward, insert the J 38125-24 in the release cavity above the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (43-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Page 4513 TERMINAL REMOVAL Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors. 1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA) device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1). 3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 4. Gently pull the cable and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector. 5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal, refer to Terminal Repair. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3. Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector. REINSTALLING TERMINAL 1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly, refer to Wiring Repairs. 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3. Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) DELPHI CONNECTORS (WEATHER PACK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 896 The engine harness may be repaired using the J-38125. High Temperature Wiring Repairs HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperatures, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time may use materials i.e. wires, connectors, and shielding that has a higher heat rating than typical wiring. When making a repair in a high temperature area observe the following: Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature to replace any damaged wire. - Replace any heat shielding that is removed. - Cover any DuraSeal splice sleeves with SCT1 shrink tubing (available in the J-38125 Terminal Repair kit). - After making a wiring repair, ensure that the location of the wiring is not moved closer to the heat source. IDENTIFYING HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperature, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time need special considerations when making wiring repairs. Areas that may be exposed to higher temperatures can be identified by heat resistant materials that are being used in those areas. These materials may include heat reflective tape, moon tape, and high temperature shrink tubing. Also conduit and other protective coverings may be used. Because conduit or similar coverings are used throughout the vehicle regardless of the temperature, it may be necessary for the technician to determine if an area is exposed to excessive heat before making a wiring repair. Obvious areas of consideration would be any area located near the exhaust manifolds, catalytic converter, and exhaust pipes. The J-38125 contains much of the material you will need to perform repairs on areas exposed to high heat. The kit contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves to crimp and seal connections - High temperature SCT1 shrink tubing to protect the splice sleeves - A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct crimp tool to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools to remove the terminals from the connectors The J-38125 does not contain wire that is suitable to high temperature exposure. Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature of the same or larger gage size as the original wire when repair damage wire. Also replace any reflective tape that you remove during the repair. HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature rating of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125 and then encapsulate the splice sleeve using the high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the order listed. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip keeping all of the wire strands intact. Engine - Low Oil Lamp ON/Oil Leaks Oil Pressure Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Low Oil Lamp ON/Oil Leaks TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 07-06-01-004A Date: November 25, 2008 Subject: All Vortec(R) GEN IV V8 Engines - LY2 LS4 LC9 LH6 LMG LY5 LS2 L76 LY6 L92 LS7, Low Oil Level Indicator Lamp On and/or Engine Oil Leak (Reseal Oil Pressure Sensor) Models Supercede: This bulletin is being updated to include a labor operation number for CTS-V and Corvette models. Please discard Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 07-06-01-004 (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System). Condition Some customers may comment on a low oil level indicator lamp on and/or engine oil leak. Upon further investigation, the technician may find that the oil leak is at the oil pressure sensor that is threaded into the valve lifter oil manifold (VLOM) assembly and/or engine valley cover. Correction If the engine oil leak was found to be at the engine oil pressure sensor, then remove the oil pressure sensor and reseal with a pipe sealant with Teflon or equivalent, P/N 12346004 (in Canada, P/N 10953480). Refer to Engine Oil Pressure Sensor and/or Switch Replacement in SI. Parts Information Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models) Page 2176 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches, and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original. - The wires insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the possibility of fuel contact. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1). 5. Select the proper duraseal splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool. Refer to the Crimp and Seal Splice Table. 6. Place the duraseal splice sleeve in the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115) crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 7. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to hold the duraseal splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 8. Insert the wires into the duraseal splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel in order to prevent the wire from passing through the splice (3). 9. Close the handles of the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115), until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is applied to the splice sleeve. 10. Shrink the insulation around the splice. - Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. - Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Splicing Inline Harness Diodes SPLICING INLINE HARNESS DIODES Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure. 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode. 2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool. 5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode. Page 4485 Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. For connectors with a bolt in the dress cover, turn the bolt counterclockwise to remove the connector from the component. 2. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. Page 5552 View of a typical Micro 64 connector. Depress the lock and pull the lever over and past the lock. Page 8533 Connector Anatomy Connector Repairs contains a list of all connector repairs. The connector repairs are listed by the connector manufacturer and then by connector type. If the technician cannot identify the manufacturer of the connector, refer to Identifying Connectors below. Knowing the connector manufacturer will assist in finding the correct connector repair from the following list: - Connector Position Assurance Locks - Terminal Position Assurance Locks - Bosch Connectors (0.64) Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) Bosch Connectors (BSK) Bosch Connectors (ECM) - Delphi Connectors (Micro.64) Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) Delphi Connectors (12-Way) - Tyco/AMP Connectors (CM 42-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) Tyco/AMP Connectors (025 Cap) Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) - Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) - Repairing Connector Terminals IDENTIFYING CONNECTORS Knowing the connector manufacturer is helpful when trying to locating the correct connector repair procedure. There are many different connector designs used on GM vehicles and it is sometimes difficult to identify the connector manufacturer. The information in this document should help with the identification of connector manufactures. The following connector manufacturers make most of the connectors found in GM vehicles: AFL/EPC (Alcoa Fujikura Ltd./Engineered Plastics Components) - Bosch - Delphi - FCI (Framatome Connectors International) - JAE (Japan Aviation Electronics) - JST (Japan Solderless Terminals) Page 6943 5. While pushing the terminal forward, insert the J 38125-24 in the release cavity above the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (43-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Page 8732 11. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 12. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 13. Center the high temperature SCT1 shrink tube over the DuraSeal splice sleeve. 14. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the high temperature heat shrink tubing. 15. Gradually move the heat from the center to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 16. Replace any reflective tape and clips that may have been remove during the repair. Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation REPAIRING DAMAGED WIRE INSULATION Wire Size Conversion Page 545 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Start in the middle and gradually move the heat barrel to the open ends of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Heated Oxygen Sensor Wiring Repairs HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being obstructed. If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. - Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks, etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire. - Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance. - To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector. Page 2617 5. Once the nose piece retainers are relaxed, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should raise slightly. 6. On the opposite side of the nose piece, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should release completely. If the nose piece does not come off, repeat the procedure on the opposite side. Page 2382 Release the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the blue locking tabs on both ends of the connector. Gently slide the TPA up to the released position on both ends. 6. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-13A (GM P/N 12031876-1) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. Page 1661 1. Install the CKP sensor. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Install the CKP sensor bolt. Tighten the bolt to 25 N.m (18 lb ft). 3. Connect the electrical connector (2) to the CKP sensor (1). 4. Install the starter. Page 8821 4. Use a small flat-blade tool to slide the terminal position assurance (TPA) up one notch on both ends of the connector. The TPA is located underneath the wire dress cover. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 7605 vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide variety of actions, including: - Wiggling the harness - Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting - Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector - Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation - Relocating a harness or wires All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. Another option is, with the component commanded ON and OFF by the scan tool, move related connectors and wiring and observe the component operation. With the engine running, move related connectors and wiring while monitoring engine operation. If harness or connector movement affects the data displayed, component/system operation, or engine operation, inspect and repair the harness/connections as necessary. You may need to load the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these cases you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide good results as well. There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions, along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the circuit to these kinds of conditions. SALT WATER SPRAY Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture. Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5 percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously. HIGH TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070. Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault condition. The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis. This option does not allow for the same control, however. LOW TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect. If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to -18°C (0°F) from one end and +71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized cooling needs. Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or components in an effort to duplicate the concern. DUPLICATING FAILURE CONDITIONS - If none of the previous tests are successful, attempt to duplicate and/or capture the failure conditions. Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, where applicable, contains the conditions that were present when the DTC set. 1. Review and record Freeze Frame/Failure Records data. 2. Clear the DTCs using the scan tool. 3. Turn the key to OFF and wait 15 seconds. 4. Operate the vehicle under the same conditions that were noted in Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, as closely as possible. The vehicle must also be operating within the Conditions for Running the DTC. Refer to Conditions for Running the DTC in the supporting text if a DTC is being diagnosed. 5. Monitor DTC Status for the DTC being tested. The scan tool will indicate Ran, when the enabling conditions have been satisfied long enough for the DTC to run. The scan tool will also indicate whether the DTC passed or failed. - An alternate method is to drive the vehicle with the DMM connected to a suspected circuit. An abnormal reading on the DMM when the concern occurs, may help you locate the concern. Measuring Frequency Page 2356 REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. The release tab is located on the top of the wiredress cover. View of connector in released position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Page 6140 breakers are used. CIRCUIT BREAKER This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high current is removed. POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) CIRCUIT BREAKER This type greatly increases its resistance when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker will re-close within a second or 2. Circuit Protection - Fuses CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSES The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and examine the element in the fuse for an open (2). If not broken (1), also check for continuity using a DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one of equal current rating. Circuit Protection - Fusible Links CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSIBLE LINKS Page 2231 Depress the locks that are located on both sides of the wiredress cover and pull the lever over and past the locks. View of the connector when released from the component. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the front of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool push down on one of the locking tabs and pull the cover up until the dress cover releases. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. Page 4372 If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200 DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J 39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected. IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J 39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and maximum (MAX) values measured. 1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of a suspected circuit to the other. 2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J 39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep). IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value in order to record the full change. 5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling the connections or the wiring, test driving, or performing other operations. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions. 6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9. Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist. Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections TESTING FOR INTERMITTENT CONDITIONS AND POOR CONNECTIONS TOOLS REQUIRED - J 35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit - J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit When the condition is not currently present, but is indicated in DTC history, the cause may be intermittent. An intermittent may also be the cause when there is a customer complaint, but the symptom cannot be duplicated. Refer to the Symptom Table of the system that is suspect of causing the condition before trying to locate an intermittent condition. Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the following items: Wiring broken inside the insulation - Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector - Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself, and corrosion in the wire to terminal contact area, etc. - Pierced or damaged insulation can allow moisture to enter the wiring causing corrosion. The conductor can corrode inside the insulation, with little visible evidence. Look for swollen and stiff sections of wire in the suspect circuits. - Wiring which has been pinched, cut, or its insulation rubbed through may cause an intermittent open or short as the bare area touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle. - Wiring that comes in contact with hot or exhaust components - Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required, in order to verify the customer concern. - Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. - Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis and Vehicle Data Recorder operation. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any inline connectors before replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation. Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination, usually in the underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit. Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper adapter. Always use the J 35616 when probing connectors. Other causes of terminal deformation are improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT IN BUSSED ELECTRICAL CENTERS (BEC) Page 185 - A control module from another vehicle is installed. - Revised software/calibration files have been released for this vehicle. - IMPORTANT: DO NOT re-program the control module with the SAME software/calibration files that are already present in the control module. This is not an effective repair for any type of concern. Verify that the control module contains the correct software/calibration. If incorrect programming is found, reprogram the control module with the most current software/calibration. Refer to Control Module References for replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Testing for Short to Ground TESTING FOR SHORT TO GROUND NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 4. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit. With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is a short to ground in the circuit. Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2. Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). - When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. - If the DMM does not display voltage 4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is shorted. Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A DIGITAL MULTIMETER NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the powertrain control module (PCM), should only be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200 Digital Multimeter (DMM). The J 39200 instruction manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminage even though voltage is present. The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity. IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading. Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the measurement. Page 3467 Fuse Block - Underhood C4 (Pin B2 To F6) Page 7663 5. Once the nose piece retainers are relaxed, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should raise slightly. 6. On the opposite side of the nose piece, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should release completely. If the nose piece does not come off, repeat the procedure on the opposite side. Page 1884 4. Use a small flat-blade tool to slide the terminal position assurance (TPA) up one notch on both ends of the connector. The TPA is located underneath the wire dress cover. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 8596 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the DuraSeal splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of a connector. CPAs are used in all SIR System connectors and also in some connectors of other systems. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals of a connection. TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE CLIPS IMPORTANT: When making a splice in an area that may be exposed to moisture use a crimp and seal splice sleeve instead of a Splice Clip. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. Page 385 View of the connector when released from the component. View of another type of Micro 64 connector. Page 2454 View of the connector when released from the component. View of another type of Micro 64 connector. Page 7042 4. Once the front 2 locks are unlocked, lift the front of the dress cover and pull it forward. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the small slot on the TPA and pushing down until the TPA releases. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to angle or rock the J 38125-21 tool when inserting it into the connector or the tool may break. Insert the J 38125-21 (GM P/N 15381651-2) tool into the round canal between the terminals cavities at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to repair Micro 64 connector terminals. The Micro 64 connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-64 (M jaw) was developed to crimp Micro 64 terminals. The J 38125-64 crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. The J 38125-64 crimping tool is also designed to crimp both the wire and the insulation at the same time. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro 64 terminals. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. 1. Cut the wire as close to the damaged terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. Page 2302 Page 1639 View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. 4. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers CIRCUIT PROTECTION - CIRCUIT BREAKERS A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types of circuit Page 2179 US English/Metric Conversion US English/Metric Conversion Page 433 Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size. REPAIRING A FUSIBLE LINK IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient overload protection. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. Flat Wire Repairs FLAT WIRE REPAIRS NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced. GMLAN Wiring Repairs GMLAN WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The GM Local Area Network (GMLAN) System requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working on GMLAN connectors and terminals. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items in order to repair the GMLAN wiring: Dura Seal splice sleeves - A wire stripping tool - J 38125-8 Crimping Tool (GM P/N 12085115) - J 38125-5 Ultra Torch Special Tool (GM P/N 12085116) The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. - A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors GMLAN REPAIRS IMPORTANT: When making a repair to any GMLAN network, the original wire length after the repair must be the same length as before the repair. If the network is a twisted pair, the twist must be maintained after the repair is completed. GMLAN has 2 types of networks, low speed and high speed. Low speed GMLAN has a single wire and works at slow speeds. High speed GMLAN has 2 wires in a twisted pair and works at higher speeds. For more information on GMLAN, refer to Data Link Communications Description and Operation. GMLAN CONNECTOR TERMINAL REPAIR IMPORTANT: A service terminal can be used to replace damaged connector terminals for both high speed and low speed GMLAN systems. When making a connector terminal repair on a GMLAN high speed system with twisted pair wires, do not untwist the wires more than necessary to make the repair. The terminals in the GMLAN system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are available in the J-38125. If the individual terminals are damaged on any GMLAN connection, use the appropriate connector repair procedure in order to repair the terminal. GMLAN WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 3260 - Most Molex connectors will have the Molex logo on the dresscover of the connector. In some cases the connectors may have MX followed by another letter. The third letter indicates where the connector was made. A connector with MXD is a Molex connector made in Detroit. Sumitomo has a unique symbol on their connector and possibly a part number. The symbol is similar to that of a diamond lying on its side, similar to that shown. The logo could appear anywhere but the most common place is at the wire side of the housing. Tyco/AMP has many different and unique connector designs. Some may or may not have identifiable marks on them. Page 7949 For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to refer to the table above. Disclaimer Page 2791 13. Slide the secondary lock (1) over the primary lock. 14. Be sure that the secondary lock tab (1) is securely in place. 15. Lower the vehicle. 16. Check the vehicle for proper operation. Page 7543 View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. View of the release tool being used for the smaller terminals. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (2-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 1668 Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair Fuel Sender Assembly Replacement Fuel Sender Assembly Replacement Tools Required J45722 Fuel Tank Sending Unit Wrench Removal Procedure 1. Remove the fuel tank. 2. Remove the fuel feed (1) and EVAP (2) lines from the fuel sender assembly. Notice: Avoid damaging the lock ring. Use only J-45722 to prevent damage to the lock ring. Notice: Do Not handle the fuel sender assembly by the fuel pipes. The amount of leverage generated by handling the fuel pipes could damage the joints. Important: Do NOT use impact tools. Significant force will be required to release the lock ring. The use of a hammer and screwdriver is not recommended. Secure the fuel tank in order to prevent fuel tank rotation. 3. Use the J45722 and a long breaker-bar in order to unlock the fuel sender lock ring. Turn the fuel sender lock ring in a counterclockwise direction. Page 4479 Refer to the following table as a guide in selecting the correct test adapter for front probing connectors: Backprobe IMPORTANT: Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures. - Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector. - Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large of a test probe. - After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected, test for proper terminal contact. Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the connector. Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure SCAN TOOL SNAPSHOT PROCEDURE Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used Page 5972 2. Locate the nose piece locking tabs that are positioned on the side of the connector nose piece. The connector nose piece acts as a terminal positive assurance (TPA) and may be referred to as such. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to push in one of the locking tabs while gently pulling on the same side of the nose piece. 4. Repeat the procedure for the other locking tab and remove the nose piece. 5. Remove the wire dress cover. The following is a general procedure for wire dress cover removal. Use this procedure as a guide, some dress cover removal procedures may vary. 6. Use fingers to squeeze the 2 locking legs of the cover. Page 5818 6. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs located on the opposite side of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover at the connector end and pry up. 7. Remove the dress cover. 8. Cut the tie wrap on the wire bundle. 9. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting a small flat-bladed tool into the small slot in the end of the slider and pushing on the TPA until it comes out of the connector. When the TPA exits the opposite side of the connector, gasp the TPA and pull it completely out of the connector. 10. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 2055 5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape. Seat Belt Schematic Icons Seat Belt Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons Page 7399 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert a small flat-blade tool in the slot below the front loaded terminal position assurance (TPA) and pry up. 3. Remove the TPA by pulling it out of the connector. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-553 (GM P/N 15315247) on a slight upward angle into the cavity below the terminal to be removed. Ensure that the pointed on the end of the tool is facing the bottom of the terminal and it stays in contact with the terminal until it stops on the plastic terminal retainer. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 4863 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link). - The wire insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. 5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold them between thumb and forefinger. 7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place. - Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction. - Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip. 8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool closes.Ensure that no strands of wire are cut. 10. Crimp the splice on each end (2). Page 6879 to analyze the data during the time a vehicle condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a trigger point that you have determined. Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2 snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a first-in, first-out basis. If a third snapshot is taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost. Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types: Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice - Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200 frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not lost if the Scan Tool is powered down. The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis. The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected values by plotting 3 parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful, especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC. Testing for a Short to Voltage TESTING FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4. Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt, there is a short to voltage in the circuit. Testing for Continuity TESTING FOR CONTINUITY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6. Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit. 7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity. With a Test Lamp IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits. 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6. If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity. Testing for Electrical Intermittents TESTING FOR ELECTRICAL INTERMITTENTS Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment. - Testing for Short to Ground - Testing for Continuity - Testing for a Short to Voltage Page 2950 1. Install the air cleaner outlet duct. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Install the air cleaner outlet duct bolt. Tighten the bolt to 10 N.m (89 lb in). 3. Tighten the clamps at the following: * MAF/IAT sensor * Throttle body Tighten the clamps to 7 N.m (62 lb in). 4. Connect the PCV fresh air tube (2) to the air cleaner resonator outlet duct (1). Page 7332 to analyze the data during the time a vehicle condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a trigger point that you have determined. Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2 snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a first-in, first-out basis. If a third snapshot is taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost. Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types: Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice - Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200 frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not lost if the Scan Tool is powered down. The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis. The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected values by plotting 3 parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful, especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC. Testing for a Short to Voltage TESTING FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4. Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt, there is a short to voltage in the circuit. Testing for Continuity TESTING FOR CONTINUITY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6. Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit. 7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity. With a Test Lamp IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits. 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6. If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity. Testing for Electrical Intermittents TESTING FOR ELECTRICAL INTERMITTENTS Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment. - Testing for Short to Ground - Testing for Continuity - Testing for a Short to Voltage Page 5313 - Most Molex connectors will have the Molex logo on the dresscover of the connector. In some cases the connectors may have MX followed by another letter. The third letter indicates where the connector was made. A connector with MXD is a Molex connector made in Detroit. Sumitomo has a unique symbol on their connector and possibly a part number. The symbol is similar to that of a diamond lying on its side, similar to that shown. The logo could appear anywhere but the most common place is at the wire side of the housing. Tyco/AMP has many different and unique connector designs. Some may or may not have identifiable marks on them. Page 7608 Refer to the following table as a guide in selecting the correct test adapter for front probing connectors: Backprobe IMPORTANT: Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures. - Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector. - Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large of a test probe. - After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected, test for proper terminal contact. Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the connector. Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure SCAN TOOL SNAPSHOT PROCEDURE Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used Page 2840 Frame Angle Measurement (Express / Savana Only) ........ Page 4616 4. Once the front 2 locks are unlocked, lift the front of the dress cover and pull it forward. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the small slot on the TPA and pushing down until the TPA releases. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to angle or rock the J 38125-21 tool when inserting it into the connector or the tool may break. Insert the J 38125-21 (GM P/N 15381651-2) tool into the round canal between the terminals cavities at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to repair Micro 64 connector terminals. The Micro 64 connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-64 (M jaw) was developed to crimp Micro 64 terminals. The J 38125-64 crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. The J 38125-64 crimping tool is also designed to crimp both the wire and the insulation at the same time. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro 64 terminals. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. 1. Cut the wire as close to the damaged terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. Page 5353 6. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by pressing on the tang. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (SENSOR) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) tool into the cavity on the lower right hand face of the connector until the terminal release tang access panel slides over. Page 1219 Outside Temperature Display Sensor: Service and Repair Ambient Air Temperature Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Remove the front grille. 2. Remove the sensor (1) from the panel assembly (2). 3. Disconnect the electrical connector from the sensor (1). Installation Procedure 1. Position the sensor to the panel assembly. 2. Connect the electrical connector to the sensor (1). 3. Install the sensor (1) to the panel assembly (2). 4. Install the front grille. Page 4819 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the TPA. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the nose piece. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. Page 5549 - JST connectors have JST in small letters on their connectors, similar to that above. The location of the logo will vary with the connector size and style. - Kostel has an "LK" with a circle around it. These connector are usually used as a transmissions connection and are currently use on some Cadillac vehicles. Page 4506 4. Once the front 2 locks are unlocked, lift the front of the dress cover and pull it forward. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the small slot on the TPA and pushing down until the TPA releases. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to angle or rock the J 38125-21 tool when inserting it into the connector or the tool may break. Insert the J 38125-21 (GM P/N 15381651-2) tool into the round canal between the terminals cavities at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to repair Micro 64 connector terminals. The Micro 64 connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-64 (M jaw) was developed to crimp Micro 64 terminals. The J 38125-64 crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. The J 38125-64 crimping tool is also designed to crimp both the wire and the insulation at the same time. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro 64 terminals. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. 1. Cut the wire as close to the damaged terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. Page 6470 5. Once the nose piece retainers are relaxed, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should raise slightly. 6. On the opposite side of the nose piece, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should release completely. If the nose piece does not come off, repeat the procedure on the opposite side. Page 8731 Open the harness by removing any tape. 2. Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. 3. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 4. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent american wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 5. Slide a section of high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing down the length of wire to be spliced. Ensure that the shrink tubing will not interfere with the splice procedure. 6. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 7. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. 8. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 9. Insert the wire into the DuraSeal splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 10. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Page 7558 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link). - The wire insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. 5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold them between thumb and forefinger. 7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place. - Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction. - Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip. 8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool closes.Ensure that no strands of wire are cut. 10. Crimp the splice on each end (2). Page 8111 Page 8730 The engine harness may be repaired using the J-38125. High Temperature Wiring Repairs HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperatures, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time may use materials i.e. wires, connectors, and shielding that has a higher heat rating than typical wiring. When making a repair in a high temperature area observe the following: Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature to replace any damaged wire. - Replace any heat shielding that is removed. - Cover any DuraSeal splice sleeves with SCT1 shrink tubing (available in the J-38125 Terminal Repair kit). - After making a wiring repair, ensure that the location of the wiring is not moved closer to the heat source. IDENTIFYING HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperature, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time need special considerations when making wiring repairs. Areas that may be exposed to higher temperatures can be identified by heat resistant materials that are being used in those areas. These materials may include heat reflective tape, moon tape, and high temperature shrink tubing. Also conduit and other protective coverings may be used. Because conduit or similar coverings are used throughout the vehicle regardless of the temperature, it may be necessary for the technician to determine if an area is exposed to excessive heat before making a wiring repair. Obvious areas of consideration would be any area located near the exhaust manifolds, catalytic converter, and exhaust pipes. The J-38125 contains much of the material you will need to perform repairs on areas exposed to high heat. The kit contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves to crimp and seal connections - High temperature SCT1 shrink tubing to protect the splice sleeves - A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct crimp tool to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools to remove the terminals from the connectors The J-38125 does not contain wire that is suitable to high temperature exposure. Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature of the same or larger gage size as the original wire when repair damage wire. Also replace any reflective tape that you remove during the repair. HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature rating of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125 and then encapsulate the splice sleeve using the high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the order listed. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip keeping all of the wire strands intact. Page 1613 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Kostal Connectors KOSTAL CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 8604 Page 4452 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link). - The wire insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. 5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold them between thumb and forefinger. 7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place. - Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction. - Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip. 8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool closes.Ensure that no strands of wire are cut. 10. Crimp the splice on each end (2). Page 7060 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Kostal Connectors KOSTAL CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 4435 5. While pushing the terminal forward, insert the J 38125-24 in the release cavity above the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (43-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Page 8168 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. JST Connectors JST CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, remove the connector from the component. Page 7234 If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the DuraSeal splice sleeves. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: - Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. - Do not use the crimp and DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 to crimp DuraSeal splice sleeve. In order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 6265 If a wire is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm, etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except coaxial. - Do not use the DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent American wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 8417 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the TPA. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the nose piece. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. Page 2458 The first connector design of the Micro-Pack 100W (1) has a white connector interface that holds the terminals. The second design of the Micro-Pack 100W (2) has a gray interface to hold the terminals. Also, the first design has terminal cavities that are further apart (3 mm centerline) and offset from the other row of terminal cavities in the connector. The second design has terminals cavities that are closer together (2.54 mm centerline) and aligned vertically. One other way to identify the second design is the thin strip of material that runs along the outside of the cavities. IMPORTANT: There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W terminals which are very similar. Ensure that you have the correct terminal before crimping the new terminal to the wire. The first design connector uses the longer terminal (1) that has a raised area in front of the recess in the terminal. The second design connector uses the shorter terminal without the raised area. Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro-Pack 100W connectors. Some Micro-Pack 100W connector disassembly procedures will vary. Use this procedure as a guide. 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 1422 Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids Arrows and Symbols Arrows and Symbols This Service Data uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations. Arrows and Symbols 1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow Basic Knowledge Required GENERAL ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures contained in the service manual. You should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current (amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram, as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. Decimal and Metric Equivalents Decimal and Metric Equivalents Page 4178 20. Remove the intake manifold gaskets (1) from the intake manifold. 21. Discard the old intake manifold gaskets. 22. If necessary, clean and inspect the intake manifold. Refer to Intake Manifold Cleaning and Inspection. Installation Procedure 1. Install NEW intake manifold gaskets (1) to the intake manifold. 2. Install the intake manifold. 3. Apply a 5 mm (0.2 in) bead of threadlock to the threads of the intake manifold bolts. Refer to Sealers, Adhesives, and Lubricants for the correct part number. Page 2690 7. Remove the 2 bolts (1) securing the seat recliner to the seat adjuster. 8. Remove the seat back assembly from the seat cushion assembly. 9. Disconnect the seat belt buckle electrical connector (1). 10. Disconnect the wiring harness (2) from the seat position switch. 11. Remove the bolt (2) securing the seat belt buckle assembly (1) to the seat adjuster. 12. Remove the seat cushion cover and foam. 13. Remove the assist spring. Page 7083 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert a small flat-blade tool in the slot below the front loaded terminal position assurance (TPA) and pry up. 3. Remove the TPA by pulling it out of the connector. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-553 (GM P/N 15315247) on a slight upward angle into the cavity below the terminal to be removed. Ensure that the pointed on the end of the tool is facing the bottom of the terminal and it stays in contact with the terminal until it stops on the plastic terminal retainer. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Locations Control Module HVAC: Locations HVAC Component Views Instrument Panel, Center 1 - Radio 2 - HVAC Control Module 3 - I/P Harness Lower Console 1 - Lower Console 2 - HVAC Control Module - Auxiliary 3 - Auxiliary Power Outlet - Console Page 1558 Page 7086 View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. 4. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers CIRCUIT PROTECTION - CIRCUIT BREAKERS A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types of circuit Page 4637 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the rear TPA from the connector. 7. IMPORTANT: The front TPA cannot be removed from the connector. Only move it to the release point. Use a small flat-blade tool to move the front TPA to the release position. 8. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 9. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Molex Connectors Page 4810 The first connector design of the Micro-Pack 100W (1) has a white connector interface that holds the terminals. The second design of the Micro-Pack 100W (2) has a gray interface to hold the terminals. Also, the first design has terminal cavities that are further apart (3 mm centerline) and offset from the other row of terminal cavities in the connector. The second design has terminals cavities that are closer together (2.54 mm centerline) and aligned vertically. One other way to identify the second design is the thin strip of material that runs along the outside of the cavities. IMPORTANT: There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W terminals which are very similar. Ensure that you have the correct terminal before crimping the new terminal to the wire. The first design connector uses the longer terminal (1) that has a raised area in front of the recess in the terminal. The second design connector uses the shorter terminal without the raised area. Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro-Pack 100W connectors. Some Micro-Pack 100W connector disassembly procedures will vary. Use this procedure as a guide. 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 5022 15. Remove the water pump bolts. 16. Remove the water pump and gaskets. 17. Discard the water pump gaskets. Installation Procedure Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. Important: All gasket surfaces are to be free of oil or other foreign material during assembly. 1. Install the water pump and NEW gaskets. 2. Install the water pump bolts. 1. On the initial pass, tighten the bolts to 15 N.m (11 lb ft). 2. On the final pass, tighten the bolts to 30 N.m (22 lb ft). 3. Install the auxiliary heater inlet and outlet hose/pipe nut. Page 274 Driver Door Module (DDM) C4 (Memory Seat Switch - Driver) (w/Memory) Page 8175 MOLEX CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. 2. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. Page 3010 Allow at least a two hour soak time between engine OFF and start up when evaluating the tick noise. 2. Start the engine and evaluate the valve lifter tick noise. ‹› If the valve lifter tick noise is still present, replace all 16 valve lifters. Refer to Valve Lifter Replacement in SI. Parts Information Note A V8 AFM engine requires 8 AFM lifters and 8 non-AFM lifters for a total of 16 lifters. Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use: Warranty Information (Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 3799 If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs SIR/SRS WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS, and the wiring components, such as connectors and terminals. IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system terminals. Use either an SIR/SRS pigtail or a terminated lead from the SIR Repair Kit Tray. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves, in order to repair the SIR/SRS wiring - A special crimping tool - A heat torch - An instruction manual The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides the necessary low resistance contact integrity for these sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors SIR/SRS CONNECTOR REPAIR (PLASTIC BODY AND TERMINAL METAL PIN) The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made with a special plating. This plating provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. Use the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit for repairing SIR/SRS terminals and connectors. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the repair kit. The J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit contains: Various terminated leads for sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) terminal replacement - Various connector positive assurance (CPA) locks for SIR/SRS connectors - Base of steering column pigtail connectors part number 12085514 - Yellow vinyl electrical tape Pigtail repair packs are available for SIR/SRS connectors with eight or less terminals. Only the connector body is available for connectors with more than eight terminals. The terminated leads in the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit can be used to replace damaged terminals when replacing the connector body. SIR/SRS COMPONENT WIRE PIGTAIL REPAIR IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails. A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device, not by a connector. If a wiring pigtail is damaged, you must replace the entire component, with pigtail. The inflatable restraint steering wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component. SIR/SRS WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 766 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link). - The wire insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. 5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold them between thumb and forefinger. 7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place. - Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction. - Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip. 8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool closes.Ensure that no strands of wire are cut. 10. Crimp the splice on each end (2). Heated Oxygen Sensor Replacement - Bank 1 Sensor 1 Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Heated Oxygen Sensor Replacement - Bank 1 Sensor 1 Heated Oxygen Sensor Replacement - Bank 1 Sensor 1 Removal Procedure Notice: Refer to Heated Oxygen and Oxygen Sensor Notice. Notice: Refer to Excessive Force and Oxygen Sensor Notice. 1. Raise and suitably support the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Unscrew the heated oxygen sensor (HO2S) sensor from the catalytic converter. 3. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) retainer. 4. Disconnect the HO2S electrical connector (3). Installation Procedure Page 4787 Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. For connectors with a bolt in the dress cover, turn the bolt counterclockwise to remove the connector from the component. 2. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. Page 1531 20. Extract a portion of the ECT sensor harness wiring and connector from the protective conduit. Cut off the ECT sensor harness connector and wiring. 21. Determine a routing path for the ECT sensor jumper harness wires so that they can be secured TO or WITHIN an existing protective conduit. Note This step is to set up and verify the length of wiring that is required before cutting. 22. Route the ECT sensor jumper wires and then enclose them in their own protective conduit in order to VERIFY the length that is required. 23. Cut the ECT sensor jumper wires to the appropriate length. Note Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splice or connector. 24. Splice the ECT sensor jumper wires to the ORIGINAL ECT HARNESS LOCATION using DuraSeal weatherproof splices. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves in SI. Note Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splice or connector. 25. Splice the ECT sensor jumper wires to the ECT SENSOR HARNESS CONNECTOR using DuraSeal weatherproof splices. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves in SI. 26. Connect the ECT sensor harness connector to the ECT sensor. 27. Secure the ECT sensor jumper wires that are in their own protective conduit TO or WITHIN the existing harness conduit using tie straps. Important You MUST run the engine at the specified RPM and until it reaches normal operating temperature and then allow it to idle as indicated in SI. The engine MUST then be allowed to cool down in order to top off the coolant level as needed. 28. Fill the cooling system to the proper level. Refer to Cooling System Draining and Filling in SI. 29. Pressure test the cooling system. Refer to Cooling System Leak Testing in SI. 30. Use a scan tool to clear any DTCs. Relocating the Engine Coolant Heater Cord Important For reference, the procedure and graphics that are shown are from a Chevrolet Silverado, but are similar for the other vehicles listed above. 1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Ask the customer where they would prefer the extension cord to exit from the engine compartment in order to determine the required extension cord length. 3. Obtain an extension cord with the following features: - 120 volt - 14/3 gauge - 15A capacity - Three prong - Polarized plug and receptacle - Chemical resistant - Grounded terminals - Designed for use in a cold outdoor environment - Outer jacket resistant to deterioration from moisture, abrasion and exposure to sunlight - Maximum length of 2.5-3 m (8-10 ft) 4. Release enough of the clips that retain the engine coolant heater cord to the vehicle to provide the necessary length for repositioning. 5. Apply dielectric grease to the electrical contacts of the heater cord receptacle and the extension cord plug to prevent corrosion. Use GM P/N 12345579 (in Canada, use P/N 10953481) or an equivalent. 6. Connect the heater cord receptacle to the extension cord plug and wipe OFF any excess grease. Locations Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Locations Engine Controls Component Views Upper Left Side of the Engine 1 - Fuel Injector 1 2 - Evaporative Emission (EVAP) Canister Purge Solenoid 3 - Fuel Injector 3 4 Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor 5 - Fuel Injector 5 6 - Fuel Injector 7 7 - Engine 8 Ignition Coil 7 9 - Ignition Coil 5 10 - Ignition Coil Harness 11 - C109 12 - Ignition Coil 3 13 - Ignition Coil 1 OnStar(R) - Incorrect GPS Position Reported During Call Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Incorrect GPS Position Reported During Call Bulletin No.: 02-08-46-006C Date: January 08, 2008 INFORMATION Subject: Incorrect OnStar(R) Global Positioning System (GPS) Location Reported During OnStar(R) Call Models: 2000-2008 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2003-2008 HUMMER H2 2006-2008 HUMMER H3 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X with OnStar(R) Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 02-08-46-006B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories). A small number of the above-mentioned vehicles may exhibit a condition in which the vehicle reports an inaccurate location to the OnStar(R) Call Center. This condition can only be identified via a button press to the OnStar(R) Call Center by the customer. Call Center personnel will be able to identify this inaccurate location condition. Customers will then be notified through the mail by OnStar(R) if their vehicle exhibits this condition. Once this condition has been identified OnStar(R) will instruct the customer to return to the dealership to have this condition corrected. It is not necessary to reconfigure the vehicle after the following procedure. In order to correct this condition you must cycle power to the OnStar(R) system. This can be done by either removing the fuses powering the OnStar(R) system or disconnecting the OnStar(R) module (VCIM) from the vehicle. As a last resort you can disconnect the vehicle's battery. The power needs to be removed from the system for approximately 15 minutes. After completing this procedure the vehicle should be taken to an area with an unobstructed view of the sky. The vehicle should be kept running for approximately 10 minutes to allow the vehicle to reacquire the global positioning system (GPS). Then contact the OnStar(R) Call Center via the blue OnStar(R) button and ask the advisor to verify the GPS position. If the OnStar(R) advisor still has an inaccurate GPS location refer to the Navigation Systems and Cellular Communications sub-sections in the Service Manual in order to diagnose and repair the concern. If the normal diagnostics lead to module replacement you will need to contact Technical Assistance (TAC) and choose the OnStar(R) prompt. GM OnStar(R) TAC will assist in the diagnosis and if appropriate order a replacement part. Replacement parts are usually shipped out within 24 hours and a pre-paid return package label will be included for returning the faulty part. By returning the faulty part you will avoid a significant non-return core charge. Warranty Information (excluding Saab US Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Warranty Information (Saab US Models) Page 8487 Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Remove the fuel tank. 2. Disconnect the fuel tank pressure sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove the fuel tank pressure sensor. Installation Procedure 1. Install the fuel tank pressure sensor. 2. Connect the fuel tank pressure sensor electrical connector. 3. Install the fuel tank. Page 7798 2. Locate the two indents of the terminal position assurance (TPA) located on the bottom of the connector body. Page 7637 The first connector design of the Micro-Pack 100W (1) has a white connector interface that holds the terminals. The second design of the Micro-Pack 100W (2) has a gray interface to hold the terminals. Also, the first design has terminal cavities that are further apart (3 mm centerline) and offset from the other row of terminal cavities in the connector. The second design has terminals cavities that are closer together (2.54 mm centerline) and aligned vertically. One other way to identify the second design is the thin strip of material that runs along the outside of the cavities. IMPORTANT: There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W terminals which are very similar. Ensure that you have the correct terminal before crimping the new terminal to the wire. The first design connector uses the longer terminal (1) that has a raised area in front of the recess in the terminal. The second design connector uses the shorter terminal without the raised area. Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro-Pack 100W connectors. Some Micro-Pack 100W connector disassembly procedures will vary. Use this procedure as a guide. 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 8132 Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. For connectors with a bolt in the dress cover, turn the bolt counterclockwise to remove the connector from the component. 2. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. Page 3263 View of the connector when released from the component. View of another type of Micro 64 connector. Page 5613 6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias. Reference the appropriate service manual wiring schematic to obtain the correct diode installation position. 7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for the soldering equipment. 8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed. 9. IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode attachment points with tape. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape. Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable SPLICING TWISTED OR SHIELDED CABLE Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable. 1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splice is made. 3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire. Staggering the splices by 65 mm (2.5 in) is recommended. 4. IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical contact with the drain wire. Re-assemble the cable. Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape. - Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1). - Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire. - Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape. Page 5333 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. JST Connectors JST CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, remove the connector from the component. Page 4836 5. Once the nose piece retainers are relaxed, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should raise slightly. 6. On the opposite side of the nose piece, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should release completely. If the nose piece does not come off, repeat the procedure on the opposite side. Page 7420 Page 7014 IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals. Front probe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the connector. IMPORTANT: When probing female 0.64 terminals, it is important to use the correct adapter. There have been some revisions to the test adapter for 0.64 terminals. The proper adapter for 0.64 terminals is the J 35616-64B which has a gold terminal and a black wire between the base and tip. Failure to use the proper test adapter may result in damage to the terminal being tested and improper diagnosis. NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Page 7774 - Kostel - Molex - Sumitomo - Tyco/AMP - Yazaki Identifying the manufacturer of a connector is often difficult. When trying to determine the manufacturer of a connector, look for specific identifying marks that are unique to that connector supplier. Most of these identify marks are hard to find or see. Check the connector carefully and refer to the information below for pictures and descriptions of connector identification markings. - Most of AFLs connectors have EPC on their connector body. Some of the smaller connectors will not have any markings on them. - In some cases Bosch will actually be printed on the connector. If Bosch does not appear on the connector, look for the Bosch logo. The Bosch logo is a circle with a blunted arrow inside. This logo can appear anywhere on the connector and is often very small. Brakes - ABS Lamp ON/DTC's C0265/C0201/U1041 Set Electronic Brake Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - ABS Lamp ON/DTC's C0265/C0201/U1041 Set TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 04-05-25-002E Date: March 11, 2009 Subject: ABS Light On, DTCs C0265, C0201, U1041 Set and/or Loss of Communication with Brake Module (Reground EBCM Ground) Models Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add step 2 to the procedure and update the Parts and Warranty Information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 04-05-25-002D (Section 05 - Brakes). Condition Some customers may comment that the ABS light is on. Upon further inspection, DTCs C0265 and C0201 may be set in the brake module. It is also possible for DTC U1041 to set in other modules. There may also be a loss of communication with the brake module. Cause A poor connection at the EBCM ground is causing unnecessary replacement of brake modules. Important: The EBCM ground is different for each application. Refer to the list below for the proper ground reference: ^ Midsize Utilities = Ground 304 ^ SSR = Ground 400 ^ Fullsize Trucks and Utilities = Ground 110 Correction Important: Do not replace the brake module to correct this condition. Perform the following repair before further diagnosis of the EBCM. Perform the following steps to improve the connection of the EBCM Ground: 1. Remove the EBCM Ground. The EBCM Ground is located on the frame beneath the driver's side door. If multiple grounds are found in this location, the EBCM ground can be identified as the heavy (12-gauge) wire. 2. If the original fastener has a welded on nut, remove the nut from the frame, and if required, enlarge the bolt hole to accommodate the new bolt and nut. 3. Clean the area, front and back, using a tool such as a *3M(TM) Scotch-Brite Roloc disc or equivalent. Page 8281 4. Use a small flat-blade tool to slide the terminal position assurance (TPA) up one notch on both ends of the connector. The TPA is located underneath the wire dress cover. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 4197 4. Brush or air blast away any dirt or debris from around the spark plug. 5. Remove the spark plug. 6. Install J 22794 into the spark plug hole. 7. Attach an air hose to J 22794. 8. Apply compressed air to J 22794 in order to hold the valves in place. 9. Use J 38606 in order to compress the valve spring. 10. Remove the valve stem keys (2). 11. Carefully release the valve spring tension. 12. Remove J 38606. 13. Remove the valve spring cap (3). 14. Remove the valve spring (4). 15. Remove the valve stem oil seal/shim assembly (1, 5). Installation Procedure Locations Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Locations Engine Controls Component Views Fuel Tank 1 - Fuel Tank Pressue (FTP) Sensor 2 - Fuel Pump and Sender Assembly 3 - Chassis Harness 4 Fuel Tank 5 - Evaporative Emission (EVAP) Canister Vent Solenoid Service and Repair Air Cleaner Fresh Air Duct/Hose: Service and Repair Air Cleaner Resonator Outlet Duct Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Disconnect the positive crankcase ventilation (PCV) fresh air tube (2) from the air cleaner resonator outlet duct (1). 2. Loosen the clamps at the following: * Mass air flow (MAF)/intake air temperature (IAT) sensor * Throttle body 3. Remove the air cleaner outlet duct bolt. 4. Remove the air cleaner outlet duct. Installation Procedure Page 6540 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. 4. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front of the connector. Page 1405 Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Connector Views Engine Controls Connector End Views Mass Air Flow (MAF)/Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor Page 8880 Front Caster and Camber Adjustment Alignment: Service and Repair Front Caster and Camber Adjustment Front Caster and Camber Adjustment The caster and camber adjustments are made by loosening the lower control arm adjustment bolts and repositioning the lower control arm. Important: Before adjusting the caster and camber angles, jounce the front bumper 3 times to allow the vehicle to return to normal height. Measure and adjust the caster and the camber with the vehicle at curb height. The front suspension Z dimension and the rear suspension D dimension are indicated in Trim Heights. Refer to Trim Height Inspection. 1. For an accurate reading, do not push or pull on the tires during the alignment process. 2. Determine the caster (2, 3) angle. 3. Determine the camber (2, 3) angle. 4. Loosen the lower control arm adjustment bolts (1). Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 5. Adjust the caster and the camber angle by repositioning the lower control arm (2) until the specifications have been met. When the adjustments are complete, hold the lower control arm in position so that the specifications do not change while tightening the lower control arm adjustment bolts. 1. Tighten the front lower control arm bracket mounting bolts to 265 N.m (195 lb ft). Page 5888 6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias. Reference the appropriate service manual wiring schematic to obtain the correct diode installation position. 7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for the soldering equipment. 8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed. 9. IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode attachment points with tape. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape. Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable SPLICING TWISTED OR SHIELDED CABLE Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable. 1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splice is made. 3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire. Staggering the splices by 65 mm (2.5 in) is recommended. 4. IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical contact with the drain wire. Re-assemble the cable. Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape. - Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1). - Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire. - Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape. Page 4182 11. Install the PCV hose. 12. Connect the electrical harness clips to the fuel rail. 13. Connect the following electrical connectors: ^ EVAP purge solenoid (3) ^ Throttle body harness (5) ^ MAP sensor (2) ^ Main coil (1) ^ Generator (4) Page 4363 Radiator Cooling Fan Control Module: Diagnostic Aids Arrows and Symbols Arrows and Symbols This Service Data uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations. Arrows and Symbols 1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow Basic Knowledge Required GENERAL ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures contained in the service manual. You should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current (amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram, as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. Decimal and Metric Equivalents Decimal and Metric Equivalents Page 6562 TERMINAL REMOVAL Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors. 1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA) device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1). 3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 4. Gently pull the cable and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector. 5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal, refer to Terminal Repair. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3. Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector. REINSTALLING TERMINAL 1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly, refer to Wiring Repairs. 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3. Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) DELPHI CONNECTORS (WEATHER PACK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 5524 Checking Aftermarket Accessories CHECKING AFTERMARKET ACCESSORIES Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits: - CAUTION: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol. - NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice. OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol. Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the cause of the problems. Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include: Power feeds connected to points other than the battery - Antenna location - Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring - Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line - Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories. Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions INDUCING INTERMITTENT FAULT CONDITIONS TOOLS REQUIRED J 25070 Heat Gun Many intermittent open or shorted circuits are affected by harness/connector movement that is caused by vibration, engine torque, bumps/rough pavement, etc. In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness if the malfunction appears to be Page 7028 5. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove TPA from the connector. 6. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Page 3223 Page 4633 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully raise the TPA on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA cannot be removed from the connector while there are terminals present in the connector body. View of the TPA when removed from the connector body. 4. Use the J 38125-12A tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the left side of the terminal release cavity as shown in the graphic. Use the tool to move the terminal release to the right with a gentle prying motion. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 7324 Engine Control Module: Diagnostic Aids Arrows and Symbols Arrows and Symbols This Service Data uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations. Arrows and Symbols 1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow Basic Knowledge Required GENERAL ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures contained in the service manual. You should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current (amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram, as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. Decimal and Metric Equivalents Decimal and Metric Equivalents Page 3739 - Kostel - Molex - Sumitomo - Tyco/AMP - Yazaki Identifying the manufacturer of a connector is often difficult. When trying to determine the manufacturer of a connector, look for specific identifying marks that are unique to that connector supplier. Most of these identify marks are hard to find or see. Check the connector carefully and refer to the information below for pictures and descriptions of connector identification markings. - Most of AFLs connectors have EPC on their connector body. Some of the smaller connectors will not have any markings on them. - In some cases Bosch will actually be printed on the connector. If Bosch does not appear on the connector, look for the Bosch logo. The Bosch logo is a circle with a blunted arrow inside. This logo can appear anywhere on the connector and is often very small. Page 8274 TERMINAL REMOVAL Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors. 1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA) device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1). 3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 4. Gently pull the cable and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector. 5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal, refer to Terminal Repair. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3. Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector. REINSTALLING TERMINAL 1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly, refer to Wiring Repairs. 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3. Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) DELPHI CONNECTORS (WEATHER PACK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 5932 Page 1121 7. Wrap electrical tape around the connection as shown. 8. Route the engine coolant heater cord and extension cord behind the alternator and adjacent to the engine coolant crossover pipe as shown. 9. Continue to route the extension cord to the exit location desired by the customer as shown. 10. Review the routing of the coolant heater cord and extension cord to verify that it does not touch any sharp edges that could damage it. 11. Secure the engine coolant heater cord and the extension cord with tie straps as needed. 12. Resecure any of the original clips that retained the engine coolant heater cord to the vehicle that were released to provide length. Part Information The extension cord may be obtained at any of the following outlets: - Lowes* - Home Depot* - Canada: Acklands-Grainger* (www.acklandsgrainger.com), Catalogue Part Number: CWRSJTOW3C14-10 USA: Cords should bear the UL symbol. Canada: Cords should bear the ULc symbol or CSA approval. *We believe these sources and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume any responsibility for the products or material from these firms or for any such items that may be available from other sources. Page 3250 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. 4. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front of the connector. Page 5840 Release the lower wiredress cover locking tab. Release the upper wiredress cover locking tab. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. Page 7316 Page 2579 5. Insert the J 38125-557 (GM P/N 12122378) into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 6. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Connector Position Assurance Locks CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of the connector. CPAs are used in various connectors throughout the vehicle. CPAs are also used in all SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals, of the connector. Connector Repairs CONNECTOR REPAIRS Page 4577 Page 7837 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link). - The wire insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. 5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold them between thumb and forefinger. 7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place. - Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction. - Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip. 8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool closes.Ensure that no strands of wire are cut. 10. Crimp the splice on each end (2). Page 5418 - A control module from another vehicle is installed. - Revised software/calibration files have been released for this vehicle. - IMPORTANT: DO NOT re-program the control module with the SAME software/calibration files that are already present in the control module. This is not an effective repair for any type of concern. Verify that the control module contains the correct software/calibration. If incorrect programming is found, reprogram the control module with the most current software/calibration. Refer to Control Module References for replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Testing for Short to Ground TESTING FOR SHORT TO GROUND NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 4. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit. With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is a short to ground in the circuit. Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2. Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). - When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. - If the DMM does not display voltage 4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is shorted. Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A DIGITAL MULTIMETER NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the powertrain control module (PCM), should only be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200 Digital Multimeter (DMM). The J 39200 instruction manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminage even though voltage is present. The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity. IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading. Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the measurement. Page 4589 Refer to the following table as a guide in selecting the correct test adapter for front probing connectors: Backprobe IMPORTANT: Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures. - Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector. - Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large of a test probe. - After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected, test for proper terminal contact. Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the connector. Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure SCAN TOOL SNAPSHOT PROCEDURE Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used Page 5365 If a wire is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm, etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except coaxial. - Do not use the DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent American wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Locations Wheel Speed Sensor: Locations Antilock Brake System Component Views Front Hubs And Rotors 1 - LH Steering Knuckle 2 - Wheel Speed Sensor - LF 3 - Wheel Speed Sensor - RF 4 - RH Steering Knuckle Page 3445 Fuse Block: Connector Views Rear Fuse Block Fuse Block - Rear, Top View Page 7175 - JST connectors have JST in small letters on their connectors, similar to that above. The location of the logo will vary with the connector size and style. - Kostel has an "LK" with a circle around it. These connector are usually used as a transmissions connection and are currently use on some Cadillac vehicles. Page 3936 Important: Recess the nose of the crankshaft 2.4-4.48 mm (0.094-0.176 in) into the balancer bore. 4. Measure for a correctly installed balancer. If the balancer is not installed to the proper dimensions, install J 41665 and repeat the installation procedure. 5. Install a NEW crankshaft balancer bolt. 1. Tighten the bolt a first pass to 50 N.m (37 lb ft). 2. Tighten the bolt a final pass to 140 degrees using J 45059. 6. Remove J 42386-A and bolts. 7. Install the starter motor. Refer to Starter Motor Replacement (4.2L Engine) Starter Motor Replacement (5.3L and 6.0L Engines). 8. Install the fan shroud. Refer to Cooling Fan and Shroud Replacement. 9. Install the A/C drive belt, if equipped. Refer to Drive Belt Replacement - Air Conditioning. 10. Install the accessory drive belt. Refer to Drive Belt Replacement - Accessory. 11. Perform the crankshaft position (CKP) system variation learn procedure. Refer to Crankshaft Position System Variation Learn. Page 2582 - In some cases Delphi will actually be printed on the connector. If Delphi is not printed on the connector, look for PED. In both cases there is no specific orientation for Delphi or PED and they can appear anywhere on the connector. - FCI connectors may have the FCI logo on their connectors. The logo is the letters FCI with an "A" above it. - JAE connector have JAE in small letters on their connectors. Page 3722 If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200 DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J 39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected. IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J 39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and maximum (MAX) values measured. 1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of a suspected circuit to the other. 2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J 39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep). IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value in order to record the full change. 5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling the connections or the wiring, test driving, or performing other operations. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions. 6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9. Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist. Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections TESTING FOR INTERMITTENT CONDITIONS AND POOR CONNECTIONS TOOLS REQUIRED - J 35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit - J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit When the condition is not currently present, but is indicated in DTC history, the cause may be intermittent. An intermittent may also be the cause when there is a customer complaint, but the symptom cannot be duplicated. Refer to the Symptom Table of the system that is suspect of causing the condition before trying to locate an intermittent condition. Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the following items: Wiring broken inside the insulation - Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector - Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself, and corrosion in the wire to terminal contact area, etc. - Pierced or damaged insulation can allow moisture to enter the wiring causing corrosion. The conductor can corrode inside the insulation, with little visible evidence. Look for swollen and stiff sections of wire in the suspect circuits. - Wiring which has been pinched, cut, or its insulation rubbed through may cause an intermittent open or short as the bare area touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle. - Wiring that comes in contact with hot or exhaust components - Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required, in order to verify the customer concern. - Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. - Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis and Vehicle Data Recorder operation. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any inline connectors before replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation. Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination, usually in the underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit. Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper adapter. Always use the J 35616 when probing connectors. Other causes of terminal deformation are improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT IN BUSSED ELECTRICAL CENTERS (BEC) Page 2369 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 6077 Release the tabs that are holding the wiredress cover to the connector body. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the slots on both ends of the connector body. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. J 38125-216 can also be used to remove the nose piece. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by lifting the terminal retaining tabs on the inside of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 6445 2. Locate the nose piece locking tabs that are positioned on the side of the connector nose piece. The connector nose piece acts as a terminal positive assurance (TPA) and may be referred to as such. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to push in one of the locking tabs while gently pulling on the same side of the nose piece. 4. Repeat the procedure for the other locking tab and remove the nose piece. 5. Remove the wire dress cover. The following is a general procedure for wire dress cover removal. Use this procedure as a guide, some dress cover removal procedures may vary. 6. Use fingers to squeeze the 2 locking legs of the cover. Page 7094 If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs SIR/SRS WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS, and the wiring components, such as connectors and terminals. IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system terminals. Use either an SIR/SRS pigtail or a terminated lead from the SIR Repair Kit Tray. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves, in order to repair the SIR/SRS wiring - A special crimping tool - A heat torch - An instruction manual The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides the necessary low resistance contact integrity for these sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors SIR/SRS CONNECTOR REPAIR (PLASTIC BODY AND TERMINAL METAL PIN) The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made with a special plating. This plating provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. Use the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit for repairing SIR/SRS terminals and connectors. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the repair kit. The J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit contains: Various terminated leads for sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) terminal replacement - Various connector positive assurance (CPA) locks for SIR/SRS connectors - Base of steering column pigtail connectors part number 12085514 - Yellow vinyl electrical tape Pigtail repair packs are available for SIR/SRS connectors with eight or less terminals. Only the connector body is available for connectors with more than eight terminals. The terminated leads in the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit can be used to replace damaged terminals when replacing the connector body. SIR/SRS COMPONENT WIRE PIGTAIL REPAIR IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails. A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device, not by a connector. If a wiring pigtail is damaged, you must replace the entire component, with pigtail. The inflatable restraint steering wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component. SIR/SRS WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 3594 *This product is currently available from 3M. To obtain information for your local retail location please call 3M at 1-888-364-3577. **This product is currently available from Meguiars (Canada). To obtain information for your local retail location please call Meguiars at 1-800-347-5700 or at www.meguiarscanada.com. ^ This product is currently available from Tri-Peek International. To obtain information for your local retail location please call Tri-Peek at 1-877-615-4272 or at www.tripeek.com. Disclaimer Page 5604 The engine harness may be repaired using the J-38125. High Temperature Wiring Repairs HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperatures, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time may use materials i.e. wires, connectors, and shielding that has a higher heat rating than typical wiring. When making a repair in a high temperature area observe the following: Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature to replace any damaged wire. - Replace any heat shielding that is removed. - Cover any DuraSeal splice sleeves with SCT1 shrink tubing (available in the J-38125 Terminal Repair kit). - After making a wiring repair, ensure that the location of the wiring is not moved closer to the heat source. IDENTIFYING HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperature, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time need special considerations when making wiring repairs. Areas that may be exposed to higher temperatures can be identified by heat resistant materials that are being used in those areas. These materials may include heat reflective tape, moon tape, and high temperature shrink tubing. Also conduit and other protective coverings may be used. Because conduit or similar coverings are used throughout the vehicle regardless of the temperature, it may be necessary for the technician to determine if an area is exposed to excessive heat before making a wiring repair. Obvious areas of consideration would be any area located near the exhaust manifolds, catalytic converter, and exhaust pipes. The J-38125 contains much of the material you will need to perform repairs on areas exposed to high heat. The kit contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves to crimp and seal connections - High temperature SCT1 shrink tubing to protect the splice sleeves - A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct crimp tool to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools to remove the terminals from the connectors The J-38125 does not contain wire that is suitable to high temperature exposure. Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature of the same or larger gage size as the original wire when repair damage wire. Also replace any reflective tape that you remove during the repair. HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature rating of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125 and then encapsulate the splice sleeve using the high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the order listed. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip keeping all of the wire strands intact. Page 8151 View of the connector when released from the component. View of another type of Micro 64 connector. Page 8239 IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals. Front probe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the connector. IMPORTANT: When probing female 0.64 terminals, it is important to use the correct adapter. There have been some revisions to the test adapter for 0.64 terminals. The proper adapter for 0.64 terminals is the J 35616-64B which has a gold terminal and a black wire between the base and tip. Failure to use the proper test adapter may result in damage to the terminal being tested and improper diagnosis. NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Page 4355 Page 9055 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Kostal Connectors KOSTAL CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 5825 - Most Molex connectors will have the Molex logo on the dresscover of the connector. In some cases the connectors may have MX followed by another letter. The third letter indicates where the connector was made. A connector with MXD is a Molex connector made in Detroit. Sumitomo has a unique symbol on their connector and possibly a part number. The symbol is similar to that of a diamond lying on its side, similar to that shown. The logo could appear anywhere but the most common place is at the wire side of the housing. Tyco/AMP has many different and unique connector designs. Some may or may not have identifiable marks on them. Page 4913 - Most Molex connectors will have the Molex logo on the dresscover of the connector. In some cases the connectors may have MX followed by another letter. The third letter indicates where the connector was made. A connector with MXD is a Molex connector made in Detroit. Sumitomo has a unique symbol on their connector and possibly a part number. The symbol is similar to that of a diamond lying on its side, similar to that shown. The logo could appear anywhere but the most common place is at the wire side of the housing. Tyco/AMP has many different and unique connector designs. Some may or may not have identifiable marks on them. Page 8211 6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias. Reference the appropriate service manual wiring schematic to obtain the correct diode installation position. 7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for the soldering equipment. 8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed. 9. IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode attachment points with tape. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape. Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable SPLICING TWISTED OR SHIELDED CABLE Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable. 1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splice is made. 3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire. Staggering the splices by 65 mm (2.5 in) is recommended. 4. IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical contact with the drain wire. Re-assemble the cable. Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape. - Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1). - Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire. - Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape. Page 5829 Depress the locks that are located on both sides of the wiredress cover and pull the lever over and past the locks. View of the connector when released from the component. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the front of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool push down on one of the locking tabs and pull the cover up until the dress cover releases. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. Page 2657 Knock Sensor: Service and Repair Knock Sensor Replacement (Right Side) Knock Sensor Replacement (Right Side) Removal Procedure 1. Disconnect the electrical connector (3) from the knock sensor (2). 2. Remove the knock sensor bolt (1). 3. Remove the knock sensor (2) from the engine block. Installation Procedure 1. Position the knock sensor (2) on the engine block. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Install the knock sensor bolt (1). Tighten the bolt (1) to 20 N.m (15 lb ft). 3. Connect the electrical connector (3) to the knock sensor (2). Page 4869 Page 2642 If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the DuraSeal splice sleeves. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: - Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. - Do not use the crimp and DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 to crimp DuraSeal splice sleeve. In order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 8247 3. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. View showing depressing of the lever lock release tab. Page 1669 4. Remove the fuel sender assembly (2) and seal (3). Discard the seal. Caution: Refer to Fuel Storage Caution. 5. Clean the fuel sender sealing surfaces (4). Important: Some lock ring were manufactured with DO NOT REUSE stamped into them. These lock rings may be reused if they are not damaged or warped. Important: Inspect the lock ring for damage due to improper removal or installation procedures. If damage is found, install a NEW lock ring. Important: Check the lock ring for flatness. 6. Place the lock ring on a flat surface. Measure the clearance between to lock ring and the flat surface using a feeler gage at 7 points. 7. If the warpage is less than 0.41 mm (0.016 in), the lock ring does not require replacement. 8. If the warpage is greater than 0.41 mm (0.016 in), the lock ring must be replaced. Installation Procedure Page 6517 Page 431 View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. 4. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers CIRCUIT PROTECTION - CIRCUIT BREAKERS A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types of circuit Page 2155 3. Ensure that the terminal release tang access panel is in the correct location to access the terminals. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) into the terminal release tang access slot located behind the access panel of the connector and press down on the terminal while carefully pulling the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Tyco/AMP Connectors (0.25 Cap) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (025 CAP) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component by pressing down on the connector position assurance (CPA). Page 1325 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (BSK) BOSCH CONNECTORS (BSK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 3. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 4. Insert the J 38125-561 tool into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 5. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is Page 5449 The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors. 1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position. 4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool J 38125-10A (GM P/N 12014012-1) into the front (mating end) of the connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal through the back of the connector (2). IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector. 6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. 7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily. 10. Perform system check. Delphi Connectors (12 Way) DELPHI CONNECTORS (12-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. Page 4439 6. Gently pry the plastic terminal retainer down and carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (16-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, pull the two connector halves apart. Page 3819 Compression Check: Testing and Inspection Engine Compression Test 1. Charge the battery if the battery is not fully charged. 2. Disable the ignition system. 3. Disable the fuel injection system. 4. Remove all spark plugs. 5. Turn the ignition to the ON position. 6. Depress the accelerator pedal to position the throttle plate wide open. 7. Start with the compression gage at zero and crank the engine through 4 compression strokes, 4 puffs. 8. Measure the compression for each cylinder. Record the readings. 9. If a cylinder has low compression, inject approximately 15 ml (1 tablespoon) of engine oil into the combustion chamber through the spark plug hole. Measure the compression again and record the reading. 10. The minimum compression in any 1 cylinder should not be less than 70 percent of the highest cylinder. No cylinder should read less than 690 kPa (100 psi). For example, if the highest pressure in any 1 cylinder is 1 035 kPa (150 psi), the lowest allowable pressure for any other cylinder would be 725 kPa (105 psi). (1 035 x 70% = 725) (150 x 70% = 105). ^ Normal - Compression builds up quickly and evenly to the specified compression for each cylinder. ^ Piston Rings Leaking - Compression is low on the first stroke. Compression builds up with the following strokes, but does not reach normal. Compression improves considerably when you add oil. ^ Valves Leaking - Compression is low on the first stroke. Compression usually does not build up on the following strokes. Compression does not improve much when you add oil. ^ If 2 adjacent cylinders have lower than normal compression, and injecting oil into the cylinders does not increase the compression, the cause may be a head gasket leaking between the cylinders. Page 1419 Page 758 If a wire is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm, etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except coaxial. - Do not use the DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent American wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 2387 View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. 4. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers CIRCUIT PROTECTION - CIRCUIT BREAKERS A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types of circuit Page 7040 View of the connector when released from the component. View of another type of Micro 64 connector. Page 2201 Checking Aftermarket Accessories CHECKING AFTERMARKET ACCESSORIES Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits: - CAUTION: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol. - NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice. OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol. Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the cause of the problems. Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include: Power feeds connected to points other than the battery - Antenna location - Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring - Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line - Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories. Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions INDUCING INTERMITTENT FAULT CONDITIONS TOOLS REQUIRED J 25070 Heat Gun Many intermittent open or shorted circuits are affected by harness/connector movement that is caused by vibration, engine torque, bumps/rough pavement, etc. In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness if the malfunction appears to be Page 4662 Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size. REPAIRING A FUSIBLE LINK IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient overload protection. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. Flat Wire Repairs FLAT WIRE REPAIRS NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced. GMLAN Wiring Repairs GMLAN WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The GM Local Area Network (GMLAN) System requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working on GMLAN connectors and terminals. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items in order to repair the GMLAN wiring: Dura Seal splice sleeves - A wire stripping tool - J 38125-8 Crimping Tool (GM P/N 12085115) - J 38125-5 Ultra Torch Special Tool (GM P/N 12085116) The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. - A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors GMLAN REPAIRS IMPORTANT: When making a repair to any GMLAN network, the original wire length after the repair must be the same length as before the repair. If the network is a twisted pair, the twist must be maintained after the repair is completed. GMLAN has 2 types of networks, low speed and high speed. Low speed GMLAN has a single wire and works at slow speeds. High speed GMLAN has 2 wires in a twisted pair and works at higher speeds. For more information on GMLAN, refer to Data Link Communications Description and Operation. GMLAN CONNECTOR TERMINAL REPAIR IMPORTANT: A service terminal can be used to replace damaged connector terminals for both high speed and low speed GMLAN systems. When making a connector terminal repair on a GMLAN high speed system with twisted pair wires, do not untwist the wires more than necessary to make the repair. The terminals in the GMLAN system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are available in the J-38125. If the individual terminals are damaged on any GMLAN connection, use the appropriate connector repair procedure in order to repair the terminal. GMLAN WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 1955 Page 4925 TERMINAL REMOVAL Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors. 1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA) device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1). 3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 4. Gently pull the cable and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector. 5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal, refer to Terminal Repair. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3. Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector. REINSTALLING TERMINAL 1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly, refer to Wiring Repairs. 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3. Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) DELPHI CONNECTORS (WEATHER PACK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 7877 8. Disconnect the 32-way tan electrical connector (2) from the BCM. 9. Disconnect the 24-way gray electrical connector (1) from the BCM. 10. With an upward motion, remove the BCM (1) from the rear electrical center. INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 1. Index the slots on the BCM (1) to the rear electrical center. 2. Using a downward motion, install the BCM to the rear electrical center. 3. Connect the 24-way gray electrical connector (1) to the BCM. 4. Connect the 32-way tan electrical connector (2) to the BCM. 5. Connect the 40-way body wiring extension (1) to the BCM. Page 828 View of connector in released position. 4. Disconnect the connector from the component. 5. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Release the rear lower half of the wiredress cover. Page 8651 vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide variety of actions, including: - Wiggling the harness - Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting - Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector - Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation - Relocating a harness or wires All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. Another option is, with the component commanded ON and OFF by the scan tool, move related connectors and wiring and observe the component operation. With the engine running, move related connectors and wiring while monitoring engine operation. If harness or connector movement affects the data displayed, component/system operation, or engine operation, inspect and repair the harness/connections as necessary. You may need to load the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these cases you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide good results as well. There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions, along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the circuit to these kinds of conditions. SALT WATER SPRAY Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture. Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5 percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously. HIGH TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070. Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault condition. The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis. This option does not allow for the same control, however. LOW TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect. If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to -18°C (0°F) from one end and +71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized cooling needs. Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or components in an effort to duplicate the concern. DUPLICATING FAILURE CONDITIONS - If none of the previous tests are successful, attempt to duplicate and/or capture the failure conditions. Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, where applicable, contains the conditions that were present when the DTC set. 1. Review and record Freeze Frame/Failure Records data. 2. Clear the DTCs using the scan tool. 3. Turn the key to OFF and wait 15 seconds. 4. Operate the vehicle under the same conditions that were noted in Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, as closely as possible. The vehicle must also be operating within the Conditions for Running the DTC. Refer to Conditions for Running the DTC in the supporting text if a DTC is being diagnosed. 5. Monitor DTC Status for the DTC being tested. The scan tool will indicate Ran, when the enabling conditions have been satisfied long enough for the DTC to run. The scan tool will also indicate whether the DTC passed or failed. - An alternate method is to drive the vehicle with the DMM connected to a suspected circuit. An abnormal reading on the DMM when the concern occurs, may help you locate the concern. Measuring Frequency Page 2203 MEASURING FREQUENCY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal. IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM to autorange to an appropriate range. 1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency measured. Measuring Voltage MEASURING VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit. 1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods: - Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. - Turn ON the engine. - Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls. - Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested. 3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The DMM displays the voltage measured at that point. Measuring Voltage Drop MEASURING VOLTAGE DROP NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points. Probing Electrical Connectors PROBING ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS Page 5573 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Kostal Connectors KOSTAL CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Vehicle - Recreational (Dinghy) Towing Information Towing Information: Technical Service Bulletins Vehicle - Recreational (Dinghy) Towing Information Bulletin No.: 00-00-89-008F Date: July 28, 2006 INFORMATION Subject: Recreational (Dinghy) Towing Page 3286 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the rear TPA from the connector. 7. IMPORTANT: The front TPA cannot be removed from the connector. Only move it to the release point. Use a small flat-blade tool to move the front TPA to the release position. 8. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 9. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Molex Connectors Page 8464 6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias. Reference the appropriate service manual wiring schematic to obtain the correct diode installation position. 7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for the soldering equipment. 8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed. 9. IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode attachment points with tape. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape. Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable SPLICING TWISTED OR SHIELDED CABLE Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable. 1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splice is made. 3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire. Staggering the splices by 65 mm (2.5 in) is recommended. 4. IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical contact with the drain wire. Re-assemble the cable. Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape. - Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1). - Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire. - Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape. Page 8154 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert terminal into the appropriate terminal holder until it hits bottom and stops. The correct terminal holder is determined by the wire size. Also ensure that the terminals wings are pointing towards the former on the tool and the release locator. 5. Insert the stripped cable into the terminal. Insulation should be visible on both sides of the terminal insulation wings. 6. Compress the handles until the ratchet automatically releases. 7. Place the terminal into the appropriate cavity and assemble the connector. Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO-PACK 100W) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W connectors. These connectors are very similar but use different terminals and have some minor physical differences also. Page 703 - Kostel - Molex - Sumitomo - Tyco/AMP - Yazaki Identifying the manufacturer of a connector is often difficult. When trying to determine the manufacturer of a connector, look for specific identifying marks that are unique to that connector supplier. Most of these identify marks are hard to find or see. Check the connector carefully and refer to the information below for pictures and descriptions of connector identification markings. - Most of AFLs connectors have EPC on their connector body. Some of the smaller connectors will not have any markings on them. - In some cases Bosch will actually be printed on the connector. If Bosch does not appear on the connector, look for the Bosch logo. The Bosch logo is a circle with a blunted arrow inside. This logo can appear anywhere on the connector and is often very small. Page 3809 Page 8209 11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the solder equipment. 12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. 13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to cover the first piece of tape. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE SLEEVES TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit IMPORTANT: Use only dura seal splice sleeves. Other splice sleeves may not protect the splice from moisture or provide a good electrical connection. Use duraseal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. Use duraseal splice sleeves where there is special requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire using duraseal splice sleeves. Page 6538 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (BSK) BOSCH CONNECTORS (BSK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 3. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 4. Insert the J 38125-561 tool into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 5. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is Page 7368 Release the lower wiredress cover locking tab. Release the upper wiredress cover locking tab. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. Page 7345 IMPORTANT: Ensure that the dress cover and connector body are both in the released position before reassembling. Failure to do so may cause damage to the connector and component. Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (0.64) BOSCH CONNECTORS (0.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While pressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock until the lever is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Pull the rubber boot that covers the wires back to expose the end of the connector dress cover. 4. Place the connector locking lever in the center of the connector. 5. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs that are on the wire end of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover and connector body and pry up. Page 2653 Page 117 networks, and will not require an upgrade in connection with the cellular industry's transition to the digital network. In order to verify the type of OnStar(R) Hardware in a vehicle, type the VIN into the VIN look-up tool, which is available at the OnStar(R) Online Enrollment website within GM GlobalConnect (for U.S. dealers) or InfoNet (for Canadian dealers). Disclaimer Page 349 Page 7834 If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs SIR/SRS WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS, and the wiring components, such as connectors and terminals. IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system terminals. Use either an SIR/SRS pigtail or a terminated lead from the SIR Repair Kit Tray. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves, in order to repair the SIR/SRS wiring - A special crimping tool - A heat torch - An instruction manual The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides the necessary low resistance contact integrity for these sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors SIR/SRS CONNECTOR REPAIR (PLASTIC BODY AND TERMINAL METAL PIN) The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made with a special plating. This plating provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. Use the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit for repairing SIR/SRS terminals and connectors. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the repair kit. The J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit contains: Various terminated leads for sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) terminal replacement - Various connector positive assurance (CPA) locks for SIR/SRS connectors - Base of steering column pigtail connectors part number 12085514 - Yellow vinyl electrical tape Pigtail repair packs are available for SIR/SRS connectors with eight or less terminals. Only the connector body is available for connectors with more than eight terminals. The terminated leads in the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit can be used to replace damaged terminals when replacing the connector body. SIR/SRS COMPONENT WIRE PIGTAIL REPAIR IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails. A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device, not by a connector. If a wiring pigtail is damaged, you must replace the entire component, with pigtail. The inflatable restraint steering wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component. SIR/SRS WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 9060 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. 4. Remove the dress cover by using a flat bladed tool to release the dress cover locking tabs and lift up on the dress cover. 5. Cut the tie wrap that holds the wires to the connector body. Page 5417 It is very important to use the correct test adapter when testing for proper terminal contact of fuses and relays in a bussed electrical center (BEC). Use J-35616-35 to test for proper terminal contact. Failure to use J-35616-35 can result in improper diagnosis of the BEC. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Separate the connector halves. 2. Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body. 3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J-38125 , test that the retention force is significantly different between a good terminal and a suspect terminal. Replace the female terminal in question. FLAT WIRE (DOCK AND LOCK) CONNECTORS There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock) connectors on the harness side or the component side. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Remove the component in question. 2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side of the connector as oil from your skin may be a source of contamination as well. 3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other imperfections that could cause poor terminal contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are uniform and free of damage or deformation. 4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the on the flat wire harness connector in order to test the circuit in question. CONTROL MODULE/COMPONENT VOLTAGE AND GROUNDS Poor voltage or ground connections can cause widely varying symptoms. Test all control module voltage supply circuits. Many vehicles have multiple circuits supplying voltage to a control module. Other components in the system may have separate voltage supply circuits that may also need to be tested. Inspect connections at the module/component connectors, fuses, and any intermediate connections between the voltage source and the module/component. A test lamp or a DMM may indicate that voltage is present, but neither tests the ability of the circuit to carry sufficient current. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Power Distribution Schematics. - Test all control module ground and system ground circuits. The control module may have multiple ground circuits. Other components in the system may have separate grounds that may also need to be tested. Inspect grounds for clean and tight connections at the grounding point. Inspect the connections at the component and in splice packs, where applicable. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Ground Distribution Schematics. TEMPERATURE SENSITIVITY - An intermittent condition may occur when a component/connection reaches normal operating temperature. The condition may occur only when the component/connection is cold, or only when the component/connection is hot. - Freeze Frame, Failure Records, Snapshot, or Vehicle Data Recorder data may help with this type of intermittent condition, where applicable. - If the intermittent is related to heat, review the data for a relationship with the following: High ambient temperatures - Underhood/engine generated heat - Circuit generated heat due to a poor connection, or high electrical load - Higher than normal load conditions, towing, etc. - If the intermittent is related to cold, review the data for the following: Low ambient temperatures-In extremely low temperatures, ice may form in a connection or component. Inspect for water intrusion. - The condition only occurs on a cold start. - The condition goes away when the vehicle warms up. - Information from the customer may help to determine if the trouble follows a pattern that is temperature related. - If temperature is suspected of causing an intermittent fault condition, attempt to duplicate the condition. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required. ELECTROMAGNETIC INTERFERENCE (EMI) AND ELECTRICAL NOISE Some electrical components/circuits are sensitive to electromagnetic interference (EMI) or other types of electrical noise. Inspect for the following conditions: A misrouted harness that is too close to high voltage/high current devices such as secondary ignition components, motors, generator etc-These components may induce electrical noise on a circuit that could interfere with normal circuit operation. - Electrical system interference caused by a malfunctioning relay, or a control module driven solenoid or switch-These conditions can cause a sharp electrical surge. Normally, the condition will occur when the malfunctioning component is operating. - Improper installation of non-factory or aftermarket add on accessories such as lights, 2-way radios, amplifiers, electric motors, remote starters, alarm systems, cell phones, etc-These accessories may lead to interference while in use, but do not fail when the accessories are not in use. - Test for an open diode across the A/C compressor clutch and for other open diodes. Some relays may contain a clamping diode. - The generator may be allowing AC noise into the electrical system. INCORRECT CONTROL MODULE - There are only a few situations where reprogramming a control module is appropriate: A new service control module is installed. Page 4468 Page 6385 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the DuraSeal splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of a connector. CPAs are used in all SIR System connectors and also in some connectors of other systems. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals of a connection. TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE CLIPS IMPORTANT: When making a splice in an area that may be exposed to moisture use a crimp and seal splice sleeve instead of a Splice Clip. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. Page 4425 5. Once the nose piece retainers are relaxed, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should raise slightly. 6. On the opposite side of the nose piece, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should release completely. If the nose piece does not come off, repeat the procedure on the opposite side. Page 2730 Steering Angle Sensor: Service and Repair Steering Wheel Position Sensor or Steering Shaft Lower Bearing Replacement Removal Procedure Caution: Refer to SIR Caution. 1. Disable the SIR system. Refer to SIR Disabling and Enabling. Notice: The wheels of the vehicle must be straight ahead and the steering column in the LOCK position before disconnecting the steering column or intermediate shaft from the steering gear. Failure to do so will cause the SIR coil assembly to become uncentered, which may cause damage to the coil assembly. 2. Position the front wheels straight ahead and lock the steering column to prevent rotation of the steering wheel. 3. Remove the intermediate shaft from the steering column. Refer to Upper Intermediate Steering Shaft Replacement. 4. Remove the steering wheel position sensor retainer screws (1). 5. Remove the steering wheel position sensor retainer (2) from the base of the steering column. 6. Disconnect the electrical connector from the steering wheel position sensor. 7. Remove the steering wheel position sensor (3) from the steering column. Installation Procedure Page 3972 Installation Procedure Important: * All gasket surfaces should be free of oil or other foreign material during assembly. * DO NOT reuse the valve rocker arm cover gasket. * The valve rocker arm cover bolt grommets may be reused. * If the oil fill tube has been removed from the rocker arm cover, install a NEW fill tube during assembly. Lubricate the O-ring seal of the NEW oil fill tube with clean engine oil. 1. Insert the NEW oil fill tube into the rocker arm cover. Rotate the tube clockwise until locked in the proper position. 2. Install the oil fill cap into the tube. Rotate the cap clockwise until locked in the proper position. 3. Install a NEW rocker cover gasket (1) into the valve rocker arm cover. Page 7019 - A control module from another vehicle is installed. - Revised software/calibration files have been released for this vehicle. - IMPORTANT: DO NOT re-program the control module with the SAME software/calibration files that are already present in the control module. This is not an effective repair for any type of concern. Verify that the control module contains the correct software/calibration. If incorrect programming is found, reprogram the control module with the most current software/calibration. Refer to Control Module References for replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Testing for Short to Ground TESTING FOR SHORT TO GROUND NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 4. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit. With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is a short to ground in the circuit. Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2. Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). - When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. - If the DMM does not display voltage 4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is shorted. Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A DIGITAL MULTIMETER NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the powertrain control module (PCM), should only be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200 Digital Multimeter (DMM). The J 39200 instruction manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminage even though voltage is present. The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity. IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading. Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the measurement. Page 8766 Page 1561 Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids Arrows and Symbols Arrows and Symbols This Service Data uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations. Arrows and Symbols 1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow Basic Knowledge Required GENERAL ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures contained in the service manual. You should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current (amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram, as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. Decimal and Metric Equivalents Decimal and Metric Equivalents Page 7457 Body Control Module (BCM) Page 1764 2. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 2555 Knock Sensor: Diagnostic Aids Arrows and Symbols Arrows and Symbols This Service Data uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations. Arrows and Symbols 1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow Basic Knowledge Required GENERAL ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures contained in the service manual. You should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current (amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram, as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. Decimal and Metric Equivalents Decimal and Metric Equivalents Page 4933 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. JST Connectors JST CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, remove the connector from the component. Page 2561 IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals. Front probe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the connector. IMPORTANT: When probing female 0.64 terminals, it is important to use the correct adapter. There have been some revisions to the test adapter for 0.64 terminals. The proper adapter for 0.64 terminals is the J 35616-64B which has a gold terminal and a black wire between the base and tip. Failure to use the proper test adapter may result in damage to the terminal being tested and improper diagnosis. NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Page 7956 Tighten Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb in). Note The repair area MUST BE properly refinished to maintain a secure, stable and corrosion-free electrical ground. 12. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and Repair in SI. 13. Verify proper system operation. M8 Weld Nut Caution Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground repair. 1. If the M8 weld nut electrical ground location is accessible from both sides of the panel, a M8 conductive bolt and a M8 conductive nut may be used to secure the electrical ground wire terminal. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 2. Select a location adjacent the M8 weld nut having 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance behind the panel surface and 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance surrounding the new electrical ground site. 3. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the surface surrounding the ground location and allow to dry. Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled. 4. Drill a 10 mm (0.40 in) diameter hole through the panel. 5. Remove paint and primer from the area surrounding the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole until bare metal is visible. 6. Select a M8 conductive bolt. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 7. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M8 conductive bolt. Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase. 8. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground wire terminal. 9. Install the electrical ground wire terminal and the M8 conductive bolt to the ground location. 10. Select a M8 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 11. Install the M8 conductive nut to the bolt and: Tighten Tighten to 22 Nm (16 lb ft). Note The repair area MUST BE properly refinished to maintain a secure, stable and corrosion-free electrical ground. 12. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and Repair in SI. 13. Verify proper system operation. M8 Weld Nut Alternative Repair Caution Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground repair. 1. If the M8 weld nut electrical ground location is not accessible from both sides of the panel, a M6 conductive rivet stud and a M6 conductive nut may be used to secure the electrical ground wire terminal. 2. Select a location adjacent the damaged M8 weld nut having 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance behind the panel surface and 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance surrounding the M6 conductive rivet stud flange. 3. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the repair site and allow to dry. Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled. 4. Drill a 10 mm (0.40 in) diameter hole through the panel. Page 4607 Connector Anatomy Connector Repairs contains a list of all connector repairs. The connector repairs are listed by the connector manufacturer and then by connector type. If the technician cannot identify the manufacturer of the connector, refer to Identifying Connectors below. Knowing the connector manufacturer will assist in finding the correct connector repair from the following list: - Connector Position Assurance Locks - Terminal Position Assurance Locks - Bosch Connectors (0.64) Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) Bosch Connectors (BSK) Bosch Connectors (ECM) - Delphi Connectors (Micro.64) Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) Delphi Connectors (12-Way) - Tyco/AMP Connectors (CM 42-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) Tyco/AMP Connectors (025 Cap) Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) - Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) - Repairing Connector Terminals IDENTIFYING CONNECTORS Knowing the connector manufacturer is helpful when trying to locating the correct connector repair procedure. There are many different connector designs used on GM vehicles and it is sometimes difficult to identify the connector manufacturer. The information in this document should help with the identification of connector manufactures. The following connector manufacturers make most of the connectors found in GM vehicles: AFL/EPC (Alcoa Fujikura Ltd./Engineered Plastics Components) - Bosch - Delphi - FCI (Framatome Connectors International) - JAE (Japan Aviation Electronics) - JST (Japan Solderless Terminals) Page 3808 Page 5660 Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids Arrows and Symbols Arrows and Symbols This Service Data uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations. Arrows and Symbols 1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow Basic Knowledge Required GENERAL ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures contained in the service manual. You should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current (amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram, as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. Decimal and Metric Equivalents Decimal and Metric Equivalents Page 6485 2. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully push the terminal position assurance (TPA) towards the face of the connector on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA is fragile and may break if not done carefully. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. 3. Use the J 38125-215 tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 8166 REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. The release tab is located on the top of the wiredress cover. View of connector in released position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Page 8240 Refer to the following table as a guide in selecting the correct test adapter for front probing connectors: Backprobe IMPORTANT: Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures. - Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector. - Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large of a test probe. - After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected, test for proper terminal contact. Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the connector. Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure SCAN TOOL SNAPSHOT PROCEDURE Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used Page 1599 7. Apply pressure and gently rock the cover until one locking leg is unseated. 8. Continue to apply pressure and rock the cover until the second locking leg is unseated. Repeat procedure for the other side of the dress cover and remove the cover. 9. Use J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) to gently lift the terminal retaining tab while gently pulling the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 10. If the terminal is severely bent or damaged, it may be possible on some connectors to push the wire out of the front of the connector instead of Page 6565 Release the lower wiredress cover locking tab. Release the upper wiredress cover locking tab. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. Page 287 Memory Seat Module - Driver C4 (w/Memory) Page 3280 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. JST Connectors JST CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, remove the connector from the component. Page 6895 5. Insert the J 38125-557 (GM P/N 12122378) into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 6. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Connector Position Assurance Locks CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of the connector. CPAs are used in various connectors throughout the vehicle. CPAs are also used in all SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals, of the connector. Connector Repairs CONNECTOR REPAIRS Page 6139 View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. 4. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers CIRCUIT PROTECTION - CIRCUIT BREAKERS A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types of circuit Page 714 2. Locate the nose piece locking tabs that are positioned on the side of the connector nose piece. The connector nose piece acts as a terminal positive assurance (TPA) and may be referred to as such. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to push in one of the locking tabs while gently pulling on the same side of the nose piece. 4. Repeat the procedure for the other locking tab and remove the nose piece. 5. Remove the wire dress cover. The following is a general procedure for wire dress cover removal. Use this procedure as a guide, some dress cover removal procedures may vary. 6. Use fingers to squeeze the 2 locking legs of the cover. Page 7419 Locations Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Locations Park Neutral Position (PNP) Switch 1 - Automatic Transmission 4L60-E/4L65-E/4L70 2 - Park/Neutral Position (PNP) Switch Page 2404 Page 4795 IMPORTANT: Ensure that the dress cover and connector body are both in the released position before reassembling. Failure to do so may cause damage to the connector and component. Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (0.64) BOSCH CONNECTORS (0.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While pressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock until the lever is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Pull the rubber boot that covers the wires back to expose the end of the connector dress cover. 4. Place the connector locking lever in the center of the connector. 5. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs that are on the wire end of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover and connector body and pry up. Page 2468 Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. FCI Connectors FCI CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 1982 5. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove TPA from the connector. 6. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Brakes - Squeak Noise On Brake Pedal Application Brake Fluid: All Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - Squeak Noise On Brake Pedal Application TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 08-05-22-002C Date: April 07, 2009 Subject: Squeak Noise On Brake Apply (Remove Brake Fluid from Master Cylinder and Refill) Models: 2004-2007 Buick Rainier 2008 Buick Enclave 2004-2008 Chevrolet Colorado, TrailBlazer, TrailBlazer EXT, TrailBlazer SS 2008 Chevrolet Malibu 2009 Chevrolet Malibu (VIN position 11, 4 Orion MI. build with Build Date Prior to April 20, 2009) 2004-2008 GMC Canyon, Envoy, Envoy XL, Envoy XUV 2007-2008 GMC Acadia 2008 Pontiac G6 2009 Pontiac G6 (VIN position 11, 4 Orion MI. build with Build Date Prior to April 20, 2009) 2007-2008 Saturn OUTLOOK 2008 Saturn AURA 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 08-05-22-002B (Section 05 - Brakes). Condition Some customers may comment on a squeak noise when the brake pedal is applied or when released. This noise is normally heard when the brake pedal is slowly applied with the engine on or off, but can occur when the brake pedal is released. The noise may be isolated to the master cylinder area. Correction To correct this concern, remove as much of the old brake fluid from the master cylinder as possible and refill with a new DOT 3 brake fluid, P/N 88862806 (in Canada, use P/N 88862807). Start the vehicle and fully cycle the brake pedal until the noise diminishes to allow the new fluid to enter the system. Parts Information Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table above. Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models) Page 5561 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Ensure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the Terminal Removal Procedure. Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PULL TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL If the terminal is visibly damaged or is suspected of having a faulty connection, the terminal should be replaced. Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors: 1. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) device and/or the secondary lock. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component or separate the connectors for in-line connectors. 3. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device. 4. Insert the proper pick or removal tool into the front of the connector body. 5. IMPORTANT: On connectors with more than one terminal the service loop may not be large enough to remove the terminal and crimp on a new one. If the terminal wire does not have a large enough service loop for removal, cut the wire 5 cm (2 in) behind the connector before removal. Grasp the wire at the back of the connector body and gently push the terminal out the front of the connector body. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. If the wire needed to be cut in order to remove the terminal, gently push a small length of the same size wire through the back of the connector cavity until there is enough wire exposed in order to crimp on a new terminal. If the wire was not cut, cut the existing wire as close to the old terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 4. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. TERMINAL INSTALLATION 1. Align the terminal and pull the wire from the back of the connector in order to seat the terminal. 2. If necessary, cut the new wire to proper length and splice with existing circuit. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. 3. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply dielectric grease to the connector. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PUSH TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Testing and Inspection Engine Mount: Testing and Inspection Engine Mount Inspection Front Engine Mount Notice: Broken or deteriorated mounts can cause misalignment and destruction of certain drive train components. When a single mount breaks, the remaining mounts are subjected to abnormally high stresses. 1. Install a pole jack underneath the oil pan. 2. Insert a block of wood between the engine oil pan and the pole jack. 3. Raise the jack until the wooden block contacts the engine oil pan. 4. Raise the engine in order to place a slight tension on the rubber cushion. Observe both mounts while raising the engine. 5. Replace the mounts if any of the following conditions exist: ^ Hard rubber surface covered with heat check cracks ^ The rubber cushion separated from the metal plate of the mount ^ The rubber cushion is split through the center ^ The mount is leaking 6. If there is movement between a metal plate of the mount and its attaching points, lower the engine and tighten the bolts or nuts attaching the mount to the engine, the frame or the bracket. Page 4716 Heater Core: Service and Repair Heater Core Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Remove the HVAC module assembly. 2. Remove the heater core access cover screws. 3. Remove the heater core access cover. 4. Remove the heater core (2) from the HVAC module assembly (1). Installation Procedure 1. Install the heater core (2) to the HVAC module assembly (1). 2. Install the heater core access cover. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 3. Install the heater core access cover screws. Tighten the screws to 1.9 N.m (17 lb in). 4. Install the HVAC module assembly. Page 953 Battery Control Module: Service and Repair Generator Battery Control Module Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Remove the negative battery cable. 2. Mark the location of the negative battery cable clips and remove the clips from the cable. 3. Remove the tape securing the generator battery current sensor to the negative battery cable. 4. Squeeze the negative battery cable branches together. Important: Note the orientation of the generator battery current sensor prior to removal. 5. Slide the generator battery current sensor (1) off of the negative battery cable. Installation Procedure Page 1868 View of the connector when released from the component. View of another type of Micro 64 connector. Page 2473 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully raise the TPA on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA cannot be removed from the connector while there are terminals present in the connector body. View of the TPA when removed from the connector body. 4. Use the J 38125-12A tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the left side of the terminal release cavity as shown in the graphic. Use the tool to move the terminal release to the right with a gentle prying motion. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 1380 5. While pushing the terminal forward, insert the J 38125-24 in the release cavity above the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (43-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Page 692 View of connector in released position. 4. Disconnect the connector from the component. 5. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Release the rear lower half of the wiredress cover. Page 8436 9. The illustration shows a cutaway view of the connector to aid the technician in releasing the terminal retainer. 10. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Terminal Position Assurance Locks TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Tyco/Amp Connectors (CM 42-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (CM 42-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the connector body and pull the CPA out. The CPA is on the wire harness side of connector. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 198 5. Insert the J 38125-557 (GM P/N 12122378) into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 6. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Connector Position Assurance Locks CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of the connector. CPAs are used in various connectors throughout the vehicle. CPAs are also used in all SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals, of the connector. Connector Repairs CONNECTOR REPAIRS Page 3395 REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. The release tab is located on the top of the wiredress cover. View of connector in released position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Page 2106 IMPORTANT: Ensure that the dress cover and connector body are both in the released position before reassembling. Failure to do so may cause damage to the connector and component. Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (0.64) BOSCH CONNECTORS (0.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While pressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock until the lever is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Pull the rubber boot that covers the wires back to expose the end of the connector dress cover. 4. Place the connector locking lever in the center of the connector. 5. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs that are on the wire end of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover and connector body and pry up. Page 4820 Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. FCI Connectors FCI CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 6534 Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. For connectors with a bolt in the dress cover, turn the bolt counterclockwise to remove the connector from the component. 2. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. Page 9033 - Yazaki has a wedge or arrow shape, similar to that shown. Delphi Connectors (Micro .64) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro 64 connectors. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. The lever lock may be located on the top or sides of the wire dress cover. Page 1401 5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape. Seat Belt Schematic Icons Seat Belt Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons Page 8459 If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the DuraSeal splice sleeves. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: - Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. - Do not use the crimp and DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 to crimp DuraSeal splice sleeve. In order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 483 5. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove TPA from the connector. 6. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Page 5873 2. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully push the terminal position assurance (TPA) towards the face of the connector on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA is fragile and may break if not done carefully. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. 3. Use the J 38125-215 tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 6215 View of a typical Micro 64 connector. Depress the lock and pull the lever over and past the lock. Page 2115 - Yazaki has a wedge or arrow shape, similar to that shown. Delphi Connectors (Micro .64) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro 64 connectors. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. The lever lock may be located on the top or sides of the wire dress cover. Page 2044 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Start in the middle and gradually move the heat barrel to the open ends of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Heated Oxygen Sensor Wiring Repairs HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being obstructed. If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. - Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks, etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire. - Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance. - To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector. Page 2052 11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the solder equipment. 12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. 13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to cover the first piece of tape. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE SLEEVES TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit IMPORTANT: Use only dura seal splice sleeves. Other splice sleeves may not protect the splice from moisture or provide a good electrical connection. Use duraseal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. Use duraseal splice sleeves where there is special requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire using duraseal splice sleeves. Page 2230 View of the connector when released from the component. View of another type of Micro 64 connector. Page 8700 View of typical connector. View of connector in released position. 1. Locate the assist lever at the back of the connector. Move the assist lever to the rear position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the dress cover. Page 1516 US English/Metric Conversion US English/Metric Conversion Page 6176 Page 3309 View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. 4. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers CIRCUIT PROTECTION - CIRCUIT BREAKERS A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types of circuit Page 8203 Open the harness by removing any tape. 2. Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. 3. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 4. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent american wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 5. Slide a section of high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing down the length of wire to be spliced. Ensure that the shrink tubing will not interfere with the splice procedure. 6. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 7. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. 8. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 9. Insert the wire into the DuraSeal splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 10. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Page 3296 3. Use a small flat-bladed tool to gently pry off the dress cover by inserting the tool under the cover opposite the harness side and prying up. 4. Remove the cover. 5. Using a small flat-bladed tool, push on the side of the nose piece retainer while pushing the nose piece forward with your thumb. This will release the terminal position assurance (TPA). 6. Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) into the corresponding terminal release cavity. The release cavities are the 2 center rows of cavities on one half of the connector. Page 5140 Diagram Information and Instructions Oxygen Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions Electrical Symbols Page 4969 11. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 12. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 13. Center the high temperature SCT1 shrink tube over the DuraSeal splice sleeve. 14. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the high temperature heat shrink tubing. 15. Gradually move the heat from the center to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 16. Replace any reflective tape and clips that may have been remove during the repair. Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation REPAIRING DAMAGED WIRE INSULATION Wire Size Conversion Knock Sensor Replacement (Left Side) Knock Sensor: Service and Repair Knock Sensor Replacement (Left Side) Knock Sensor Replacement (Left Side) Removal Procedure 1. Remove the mounting bolt for the knock sensor 1. 2. Disconnect the electrical connector of the knock sensor from the engine harness (3). 3. Remove the knock sensor (2) from the engine block (4). Installation Procedure 1. Reconnect the engine harness (3) and the knock sensor (2) electrical connectors. 2. Position the knock sensor 2 on the engine block (4). 3. Install the mounting bolt (1) for the knock sensor 2. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 4. Tighten the knock sensor mounting bolt (1). Tighten the knock sensor mounting bolt to 20 N.m (15 lb ft). Page 8806 Depress the locks that are located on both sides of the wiredress cover and pull the lever over and past the locks. View of the connector when released from the component. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the front of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool push down on one of the locking tabs and pull the cover up until the dress cover releases. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. Page 8067 If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs SIR/SRS WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS, and the wiring components, such as connectors and terminals. IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system terminals. Use either an SIR/SRS pigtail or a terminated lead from the SIR Repair Kit Tray. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves, in order to repair the SIR/SRS wiring - A special crimping tool - A heat torch - An instruction manual The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides the necessary low resistance contact integrity for these sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors SIR/SRS CONNECTOR REPAIR (PLASTIC BODY AND TERMINAL METAL PIN) The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made with a special plating. This plating provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. Use the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit for repairing SIR/SRS terminals and connectors. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the repair kit. The J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit contains: Various terminated leads for sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) terminal replacement - Various connector positive assurance (CPA) locks for SIR/SRS connectors - Base of steering column pigtail connectors part number 12085514 - Yellow vinyl electrical tape Pigtail repair packs are available for SIR/SRS connectors with eight or less terminals. Only the connector body is available for connectors with more than eight terminals. The terminated leads in the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit can be used to replace damaged terminals when replacing the connector body. SIR/SRS COMPONENT WIRE PIGTAIL REPAIR IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails. A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device, not by a connector. If a wiring pigtail is damaged, you must replace the entire component, with pigtail. The inflatable restraint steering wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component. SIR/SRS WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 2175 11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the solder equipment. 12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. 13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to cover the first piece of tape. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE SLEEVES TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit IMPORTANT: Use only dura seal splice sleeves. Other splice sleeves may not protect the splice from moisture or provide a good electrical connection. Use duraseal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. Use duraseal splice sleeves where there is special requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire using duraseal splice sleeves. Page 5307 11. Insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) into the 2 triangular cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 12. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE 1. Prior to installation the terminal must be aligned so the (1) coding lugs align with the (2) coding grooves on the connector. 2. Once the terminal is aligned, slide the terminal into the cavity until the retainer has engaged in the cavity of the connector. 3. Slide the TPA in the connector body and seat it using a small flat bladed tool. The TPA is seated when it is flush with the contact housing. 4. Secure the wires to the connector body using a tie wrap and replace the dress cover and grommet. Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) BOSCH CONNECTORS (2.8 JPT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Pull out the slider on the connector position assurance (CPA) until it is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 5638 under pressure if the radiator cap or the surge tank cap is removed while the engine and radiator are still hot. 4. Remove the surge tank fill cap from the surge tank or the coolant pressure cap from the radiator. 5. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle in SI. 6. Place a clean drain pan under the radiator drain cock or under the lower radiator hose depending on the vehicle. Refer to Cooling System Draining and Filling in SI. 7. Loosen the radiator drain cock if equipped or use J 38185 clamp pliers and reposition the clamp on the lower radiator hose at the radiator. 8. Remove the end of the lower radiator hose from the radiator. 9. Drain the engine coolant sufficiently below the level of the ECT sensor. 10. Close the radiator drain cock or connect the lower radiator hose at the radiator. 11. Use the J 38185 clamp pliers to place the clamp into the original position on the hose. 12. Lower the vehicle. 13. Disconnect the wiring harness connector from the ECT sensor (2). 14. Remove the ECT sensor (1) from the front of the cylinder head. 15. Remove the corresponding size plug at the rear of the OTHER cylinder head. 16. Coat the threads of the ECT sensor with sealer. Use GM P/N 12346004 (Canadian P/N 10953480) or an equivalent. 17. Install the ECT sensor in the hole of the cylinder head where the plug was removed. Tighten Tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb ft). 18. Coat the threads of the plug with sealer. Use GM P/N 12346004 (Canadian P/N 10953480) or an equivalent. 19. Install the plug in the hole of the cylinder head where the ECT sensor was removed Tighten Tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb ft). Important Leave enough wire attached to the ECT sensor harness connector in order to create manageable splices that are at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splice. Page 890 2. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully push the terminal position assurance (TPA) towards the face of the connector on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA is fragile and may break if not done carefully. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. 3. Use the J 38125-215 tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 4638 MOLEX CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. 2. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. Page 345 Page 3355 Refer to the following table as a guide in selecting the correct test adapter for front probing connectors: Backprobe IMPORTANT: Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures. - Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector. - Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large of a test probe. - After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected, test for proper terminal contact. Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the connector. Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure SCAN TOOL SNAPSHOT PROCEDURE Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used Page 5220 5. While pushing the terminal forward, insert the J 38125-24 in the release cavity above the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (43-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Page 4432 6. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by pressing on the tang. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (SENSOR) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) tool into the cavity on the lower right hand face of the connector until the terminal release tang access panel slides over. Page 1990 - JST connectors have JST in small letters on their connectors, similar to that above. The location of the logo will vary with the connector size and style. - Kostel has an "LK" with a circle around it. These connector are usually used as a transmissions connection and are currently use on some Cadillac vehicles. Page 6145 Open the harness by removing any tape. 2. Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. 3. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 4. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent american wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 5. Slide a section of high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing down the length of wire to be spliced. Ensure that the shrink tubing will not interfere with the splice procedure. 6. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 7. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. 8. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 9. Insert the wire into the DuraSeal splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 10. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Page 8215 Page 3233 Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Page 7484 View of connector in released position. 4. Disconnect the connector from the component. 5. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Release the rear lower half of the wiredress cover. Page 6434 - Kostel - Molex - Sumitomo - Tyco/AMP - Yazaki Identifying the manufacturer of a connector is often difficult. When trying to determine the manufacturer of a connector, look for specific identifying marks that are unique to that connector supplier. Most of these identify marks are hard to find or see. Check the connector carefully and refer to the information below for pictures and descriptions of connector identification markings. - Most of AFLs connectors have EPC on their connector body. Some of the smaller connectors will not have any markings on them. - In some cases Bosch will actually be printed on the connector. If Bosch does not appear on the connector, look for the Bosch logo. The Bosch logo is a circle with a blunted arrow inside. This logo can appear anywhere on the connector and is often very small. Page 5520 All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system. Page 8358 Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Install the ECT sensor. Tighten the sensor to 20 N.m (15 lb ft). 3. Connect the ECT sensor electrical connector (1). 4. Refill the engine coolant. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System (LL8) Draining and Filling Cooling System (LH6, LS2). Page 9065 5. Once the nose piece retainers are relaxed, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should raise slightly. 6. On the opposite side of the nose piece, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should release completely. If the nose piece does not come off, repeat the procedure on the opposite side. Page 7464 Page 5264 Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Testing and Inspection Powertrain Relay Diagnosis Diagnostic Instructions * Perform the Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle prior to using this diagnostic procedure. * Strategy Based Diagnosis for an overview of the diagnostic approach. * Diagnostic Procedure Instructions provide an overview of each diagnostic category. Typical Scan Tool Data Circuit/System Description The powertrain relay is a normally open relay. The relay armature is held in the open position by spring tension. Battery positive voltage is supplied directly to the relay coil and the armature contact at all times. The engine control module (ECM) supplies the ground path to the relay coil control circuit via an internal integrated circuit called an output driver module (ODM). The ODM output control is configured to operate as a low side driver for the powertrain relay. The ODM for the powertrain relay also incorporates a fault detection circuit, which is continuously monitored by the ECM. When the ECM commands the powertrain relay ON, ignition 1 voltage is supplied to the ECM, and to several additional circuits. Diagnostic Aids This test procedure requires that the vehicle battery has passed a load test and is completely charged. Refer to Battery Inspection/Test. See: Starting and Charging/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics/Battery Inspection/Test Circuit/System Verification Important: On the scan tool, the powertrain relay is referred to as the EC ignition relay. 1. Ignition ON, engine OFF, command the powertrain relay ON and OFF several times using the scan tool output control function. You should either hear or feel the relay click with each command. 2. Ignition ON, engine OFF, with a test lamp, probe both test points of all the fuses that are powered by the powertrain relay. The test lamp should illuminate on at least one test point of each fuse. ‹› If the vehicle passes the Circuit/System Verification test, then operate the vehicle within the Conditions for Running the DTC. You may also operate the vehicle within the conditions that are captured in the Freeze Frame/Failure Records Data list. Circuit/System Testing 1. Ignition OFF, disconnect the powertrain relay. 2. Ignition ON, verify that a test lamp does not illuminate between the relay coil control circuit and ground. ‹› If the test lamp illuminates, test the relay coil control circuit for a short to voltage. If the circuit tests normal, replace the ECM. 3. Verify that a test lamp does not illuminate between the relay ignition 1 voltage circuit and ground. ‹› If the test lamp illuminates, test the relay ignition 1 voltage circuit for a short to voltage. If the circuit tests normal, replace the ECM. 4. Verify that a test lamp illuminates between the relay coil B+ and ground. ‹› If the test lamp does not illuminate, test the relay coil B+ circuit for a short to ground or an open/high resistance. 5. Verify that a test lamp illuminates between the relay switch B+ and ground. ‹› If the test lamp does not illuminate, test the relay switch B+ circuit for a short to ground or an open/high resistance. If the circuits test normal and the fuse for the ignition 1 voltage circuit is open, test the ignition 1 voltage circuit to the ECM for a short to ground. If the circuit tests Page 1906 3. Ensure that the terminal release tang access panel is in the correct location to access the terminals. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) into the terminal release tang access slot located behind the access panel of the connector and press down on the terminal while carefully pulling the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Tyco/AMP Connectors (0.25 Cap) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (025 CAP) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component by pressing down on the connector position assurance (CPA). Page 7424 Engine Control Module (ECM) C2 (Pin 1 To 10) Page 2057 Page 745 4. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the rear of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. 5. Once the locking tabs are unlocked, slide the inner connector out of the rear of the connector housing. Page 6081 5. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove TPA from the connector. 6. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Page 5987 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Kostal Connectors KOSTAL CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 2430 to analyze the data during the time a vehicle condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a trigger point that you have determined. Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2 snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a first-in, first-out basis. If a third snapshot is taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost. Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types: Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice - Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200 frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not lost if the Scan Tool is powered down. The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis. The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected values by plotting 3 parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful, especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC. Testing for a Short to Voltage TESTING FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4. Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt, there is a short to voltage in the circuit. Testing for Continuity TESTING FOR CONTINUITY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6. Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit. 7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity. With a Test Lamp IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits. 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6. If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity. Testing for Electrical Intermittents TESTING FOR ELECTRICAL INTERMITTENTS Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment. - Testing for Short to Ground - Testing for Continuity - Testing for a Short to Voltage Page 3909 7. Wrap electrical tape around the connection as shown. 8. Route the engine coolant heater cord and extension cord behind the alternator and adjacent to the engine coolant crossover pipe as shown. 9. Continue to route the extension cord to the exit location desired by the customer as shown. 10. Review the routing of the coolant heater cord and extension cord to verify that it does not touch any sharp edges that could damage it. 11. Secure the engine coolant heater cord and the extension cord with tie straps as needed. 12. Resecure any of the original clips that retained the engine coolant heater cord to the vehicle that were released to provide length. Part Information The extension cord may be obtained at any of the following outlets: - Lowes* - Home Depot* - Canada: Acklands-Grainger* (www.acklandsgrainger.com), Catalogue Part Number: CWRSJTOW3C14-10 USA: Cords should bear the UL symbol. Canada: Cords should bear the ULc symbol or CSA approval. *We believe these sources and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume any responsibility for the products or material from these firms or for any such items that may be available from other sources. Crankshaft Position Sensor Replacement Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Crankshaft Position Sensor Replacement Crankshaft Position Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure Important: Perform Crankshaft Position System Variation Learn whenever the crankshaft position (CKP) sensor is removed or replaced. 1. Remove the starter. 2. Disconnect the electrical connector (2) from the CKP sensor (1). 3. Clean the area around the CKP sensor before removal in order to avoid debris from entering the engine. 4. Remove the CKP sensor bolt. 5. Remove the CKP sensor. Installation Procedure Page 2002 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Ensure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the Terminal Removal Procedure. Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PULL TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL If the terminal is visibly damaged or is suspected of having a faulty connection, the terminal should be replaced. Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors: 1. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) device and/or the secondary lock. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component or separate the connectors for in-line connectors. 3. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device. 4. Insert the proper pick or removal tool into the front of the connector body. 5. IMPORTANT: On connectors with more than one terminal the service loop may not be large enough to remove the terminal and crimp on a new one. If the terminal wire does not have a large enough service loop for removal, cut the wire 5 cm (2 in) behind the connector before removal. Grasp the wire at the back of the connector body and gently push the terminal out the front of the connector body. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. If the wire needed to be cut in order to remove the terminal, gently push a small length of the same size wire through the back of the connector cavity until there is enough wire exposed in order to crimp on a new terminal. If the wire was not cut, cut the existing wire as close to the old terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 4. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. TERMINAL INSTALLATION 1. Align the terminal and pull the wire from the back of the connector in order to seat the terminal. 2. If necessary, cut the new wire to proper length and splice with existing circuit. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. 3. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply dielectric grease to the connector. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PUSH TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 2910 Ignition Cable: Service and Repair Spark Plug Wire Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Remove the spark plug wire from the spark plug. * Twist each spark plug 1/2 turn. * Pull only on the boot in order to remove the wire from each spark plug. 2. Remove the spark plug wire from the ignition coil. * Twist each spark plug boot 1/2 turn. * Pull only on the boot in order to remove the wires from the ignition coil. Installation Procedure 1. Install the spark plug wire to the ignition coil. 2. Install the spark plug wire to the spark plug. 3. Inspect the wires for proper installation: * Push sideways on each boot in order to inspect the seating. * Reinstall any loose boot. Page 34 In summary, whenever a vehicle subject to this program enters your vehicle inventory, or is in your dealership/facility for service through April 30, 2011, you must take the steps necessary to be sure the program correction has been made before selling or releasing the vehicle. Disclaimer Service Procedure Service Procedure Note Do NOT replace the inside rear view mirror in tandem with this concern. The mirror has no bearing on this specific issue. 1. Remove the OnStar(R) module (referred to as the Communication Interface Module (CIM) or Vehicle Communication Interface Module (VCIM) in SI). Refer to SI for module removal instructions. Note Inform customer that all Bluetooth devices must be paired with the new VCIM. Bluetooth devices that have not been paired to the new VCIM will not function properly. 2. Install the new OnStar(R) module (referred to as the Communication Interface Module (CIM) or Vehicle Communication Interface Module (VCIM) in SI). Refer to SI for module installation instructions. Page 5208 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 2019 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. 4. Remove the dress cover by using a flat bladed tool to release the dress cover locking tabs and lift up on the dress cover. 5. Cut the tie wrap that holds the wires to the connector body. Page 8914 - Kostel - Molex - Sumitomo - Tyco/AMP - Yazaki Identifying the manufacturer of a connector is often difficult. When trying to determine the manufacturer of a connector, look for specific identifying marks that are unique to that connector supplier. Most of these identify marks are hard to find or see. Check the connector carefully and refer to the information below for pictures and descriptions of connector identification markings. - Most of AFLs connectors have EPC on their connector body. Some of the smaller connectors will not have any markings on them. - In some cases Bosch will actually be printed on the connector. If Bosch does not appear on the connector, look for the Bosch logo. The Bosch logo is a circle with a blunted arrow inside. This logo can appear anywhere on the connector and is often very small. Page 8927 pulling it through. This will prevent damage to the internal seals of the connector. Once the terminal is pushed out of the connector, cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible and pull the wire through the connector. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE The Micro-Pack 100W connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool was developed to crimp Micro-Pack 100W terminals. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 2. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert the terminal into the crimp tool until the core wings are flush with the anvil on the crimp tool. Be sure that the wings are pointed toward the crimp tool former and release the spring locator. The locator will hold the terminal in place. Inspect the alignment of the terminal wings with the crimp tool former. If the terminal wings are wider than the crimp tool former, remove the terminal and bend the terminal wings in slightly. 5. Place stripped wire into terminal. 6. Crimp the new terminal to the wire. If a jam occurs, press the emergency release to open applicator. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire perform the following procedure in order to replace Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. Page 8832 8. Insert the J 38125-213 into the small terminal release hole on the nose piece and gently pull on the back of the wire. 9. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Repairing Connector Terminals REPAIRING CONNECTOR TERMINALS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following: Push to Seat terminals - Pull to Seat terminals Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your terminal repair. The J-38125 contains further information. 1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.For cable seal terminals, remove the seal. 2. Apply the correct cable seal per gage size of the wire, if used.Slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation removal. 3. Remove the insulation. 4. For sealed terminals only, align the seal with the end of the cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal.For sealed terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal. 6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.For sealed terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable. 8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals excepting Micro-Pack 100.64 size. Soldering Micro-Pack 100 World terminals may damage the terminal. Sumitomo Connectors SUMITOMO CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit OnStar(R) - Negative Impact of Cloth/Vinyl Roofs Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Negative Impact of Cloth/Vinyl Roofs INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 02-08-44-007D Date: May 12, 2009 Subject: Negative Impact of Dealer-Installed Cloth/Vinyl Roofs on XM Radio and/or OnStar(R) Systems Models: 2002-2009 Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2003-2009 HUMMER H2 2006-2009 HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X with XM Radio (RPO U2K) and/or OnStar(R) (RPO UE1) .............................................................................................................................................................. .................................................................................. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to include the 2009 model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 02-08-44-007C (Section 08 - Body and Accessories). .............................................................................................................................................................. .................................................................................. Dealers should not install a cloth or vinyl roof on vehicles that have been ordered with the XM radio option (RPO U2K) and/or OnStar(R) (RPO UE1). The performance of these systems may be negatively impacted by the installation of the cloth/vinyl roof. Additionally, water leaks may result from installing a cloth or vinyl roof on vehicles with roof-mounted antenna systems. Relocating the antenna to another spot on the vehicle exterior, in order to install a cloth or vinyl roof, is not advised either. The performance of the OnStar(R) and XM Radio antennas has been optimized for their current locations. Relocating the antennas may result in a performance degradation. Disclaimer Page 8061 Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size. REPAIRING A FUSIBLE LINK IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient overload protection. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. Flat Wire Repairs FLAT WIRE REPAIRS NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced. GMLAN Wiring Repairs GMLAN WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The GM Local Area Network (GMLAN) System requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working on GMLAN connectors and terminals. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items in order to repair the GMLAN wiring: Dura Seal splice sleeves - A wire stripping tool - J 38125-8 Crimping Tool (GM P/N 12085115) - J 38125-5 Ultra Torch Special Tool (GM P/N 12085116) The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. - A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors GMLAN REPAIRS IMPORTANT: When making a repair to any GMLAN network, the original wire length after the repair must be the same length as before the repair. If the network is a twisted pair, the twist must be maintained after the repair is completed. GMLAN has 2 types of networks, low speed and high speed. Low speed GMLAN has a single wire and works at slow speeds. High speed GMLAN has 2 wires in a twisted pair and works at higher speeds. For more information on GMLAN, refer to Data Link Communications Description and Operation. GMLAN CONNECTOR TERMINAL REPAIR IMPORTANT: A service terminal can be used to replace damaged connector terminals for both high speed and low speed GMLAN systems. When making a connector terminal repair on a GMLAN high speed system with twisted pair wires, do not untwist the wires more than necessary to make the repair. The terminals in the GMLAN system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are available in the J-38125. If the individual terminals are damaged on any GMLAN connection, use the appropriate connector repair procedure in order to repair the terminal. GMLAN WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 3971 10. Remove the valve rocker arm cover bolts. 11. Remove the valve rocker arm cover. 12. Remove the gasket (1) from the rocker cover. 13. Discard the OLD gasket. 14. Remove the oil fill cap from the oil fill tube. 15. Remove the oil fill tube from the rocker cover, if required. 16. Discard the oil fill tube. Page 4768 Page 2137 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Kostal Connectors KOSTAL CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 9037 4. Once the front 2 locks are unlocked, lift the front of the dress cover and pull it forward. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the small slot on the TPA and pushing down until the TPA releases. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to angle or rock the J 38125-21 tool when inserting it into the connector or the tool may break. Insert the J 38125-21 (GM P/N 15381651-2) tool into the round canal between the terminals cavities at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to repair Micro 64 connector terminals. The Micro 64 connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-64 (M jaw) was developed to crimp Micro 64 terminals. The J 38125-64 crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. The J 38125-64 crimping tool is also designed to crimp both the wire and the insulation at the same time. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro 64 terminals. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. 1. Cut the wire as close to the damaged terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. Page 5560 pulling it through. This will prevent damage to the internal seals of the connector. Once the terminal is pushed out of the connector, cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible and pull the wire through the connector. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE The Micro-Pack 100W connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool was developed to crimp Micro-Pack 100W terminals. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 2. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert the terminal into the crimp tool until the core wings are flush with the anvil on the crimp tool. Be sure that the wings are pointed toward the crimp tool former and release the spring locator. The locator will hold the terminal in place. Inspect the alignment of the terminal wings with the crimp tool former. If the terminal wings are wider than the crimp tool former, remove the terminal and bend the terminal wings in slightly. 5. Place stripped wire into terminal. 6. Crimp the new terminal to the wire. If a jam occurs, press the emergency release to open applicator. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire perform the following procedure in order to replace Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. Page 7907 3. Connect the MDI to a PC or laptop that has been downloaded with the GDS application from TIS2WEB. Note At least one Diagnostic Package must be installed on the PC to perform diagnostics. If GDS was just installed, select: Add New Diagnostic Package and then select: a Diagnostic Package to download. 4. Click: On the GDS icon on the PC. 5. The Login Page will appear. 6. Select: A User. 7. The ID Screen will appear. 8. Select: The serial number of the MDI being used. 9. Select: Connect. 10. Verify that the system status is ready by observing for a flashing PC light icon on the MDI. 11. Select: Make, Model and Model Year, in order to build the vehicle. 12. Click: Upload VIN, to allow the VIN to be reported to the PC. 13. At: The Verification step, turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. 14. Select: Next Action. 15. The Home Page will appear. 16. Select: Next. 17. The Diagnostic Screen will appear. Note Due to vehicle build, software and RPO variations, GDS may ask for additional information in Step 18. 18. Select: Engine ID, if prompted. 19. Select: Module Diagnostics. 20. Select: ECM. 21. Select: ID Information. 22. The Diagnostics page will appear. Typical View of GDS Calibration History Screen Note GDS is capable of displaying up to 10 Calibration History events. 23. Select: Calibration History from the drop down menu in order to display the following items on the screen: - Calibration History Buffer - Number of Calibration History Events Stored - Calibration Part Number History - Calibration Verification Number History 24. Select: Screenshot. 25. Name and save the file in an appropriate folder. 26. Select : Print, and retain a copy of the screenshot with the repair order. 27. E-mail a copy of the screenshot to [email protected]. In the subject line of the e-mail include the phrase "V8 Cal" as well as the complete VIN and Dealer BAC. In the body of the e-mail, include the VIN, mileage, R.O. number and BAC. Include a brief description of the customer concern and cause of the concern. Page 7073 3. Use a small flat-bladed tool to gently pry off the dress cover by inserting the tool under the cover opposite the harness side and prying up. 4. Remove the cover. 5. Using a small flat-bladed tool, push on the side of the nose piece retainer while pushing the nose piece forward with your thumb. This will release the terminal position assurance (TPA). 6. Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) into the corresponding terminal release cavity. The release cavities are the 2 center rows of cavities on one half of the connector. Page 2644 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link). - The wire insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. 5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold them between thumb and forefinger. 7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place. - Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction. - Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip. 8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool closes.Ensure that no strands of wire are cut. 10. Crimp the splice on each end (2). Page 2140 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the rear TPA from the connector. 7. IMPORTANT: The front TPA cannot be removed from the connector. Only move it to the release point. Use a small flat-blade tool to move the front TPA to the release position. 8. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 9. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Molex Connectors Page 4496 5. Insert the J 38125-557 (GM P/N 12122378) into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 6. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Connector Position Assurance Locks CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of the connector. CPAs are used in various connectors throughout the vehicle. CPAs are also used in all SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals, of the connector. Connector Repairs CONNECTOR REPAIRS Page 7247 1. Install the CKP sensor. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Install the CKP sensor bolt. Tighten the bolt to 25 N.m (18 lb ft). 3. Connect the electrical connector (2) to the CKP sensor (1). 4. Install the starter. Page 1945 1. If reinstalling the old sensor, coat the threads with anti-seize compound GM P/N 12377953, or equivalent. Notice: Refer to Component Fastener Tightening Notice. 2. Install the HO2S (2). Tighten the sensor to 42 N.m (31 lb ft). 3. Connect the HO2S electrical connector. 4. Install the CPA retainer. 5. Lower the vehicle. Page 7242 Page 1462 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Ensure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the Terminal Removal Procedure. Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PULL TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL If the terminal is visibly damaged or is suspected of having a faulty connection, the terminal should be replaced. Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors: 1. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) device and/or the secondary lock. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component or separate the connectors for in-line connectors. 3. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device. 4. Insert the proper pick or removal tool into the front of the connector body. 5. IMPORTANT: On connectors with more than one terminal the service loop may not be large enough to remove the terminal and crimp on a new one. If the terminal wire does not have a large enough service loop for removal, cut the wire 5 cm (2 in) behind the connector before removal. Grasp the wire at the back of the connector body and gently push the terminal out the front of the connector body. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. If the wire needed to be cut in order to remove the terminal, gently push a small length of the same size wire through the back of the connector cavity until there is enough wire exposed in order to crimp on a new terminal. If the wire was not cut, cut the existing wire as close to the old terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 4. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. TERMINAL INSTALLATION 1. Align the terminal and pull the wire from the back of the connector in order to seat the terminal. 2. If necessary, cut the new wire to proper length and splice with existing circuit. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. 3. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply dielectric grease to the connector. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PUSH TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 1590 - Most Molex connectors will have the Molex logo on the dresscover of the connector. In some cases the connectors may have MX followed by another letter. The third letter indicates where the connector was made. A connector with MXD is a Molex connector made in Detroit. Sumitomo has a unique symbol on their connector and possibly a part number. The symbol is similar to that of a diamond lying on its side, similar to that shown. The logo could appear anywhere but the most common place is at the wire side of the housing. Tyco/AMP has many different and unique connector designs. Some may or may not have identifiable marks on them. Page 304 Memory Seat Module - Driver C4 (w/Memory) Page 2016 4. Slide the dress cover forward and off of the connector. 5. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front and rear of the connector. Page 8440 4. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the rear of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. 5. Once the locking tabs are unlocked, slide the inner connector out of the rear of the connector housing. Page 5232 Open the harness by removing any tape. 2. Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. 3. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 4. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent american wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 5. Slide a section of high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing down the length of wire to be spliced. Ensure that the shrink tubing will not interfere with the splice procedure. 6. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 7. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. 8. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 9. Insert the wire into the DuraSeal splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 10. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Page 1499 2. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully push the terminal position assurance (TPA) towards the face of the connector on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA is fragile and may break if not done carefully. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. 3. Use the J 38125-215 tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 9002 All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system. Page 7244 Crankshaft Position Sensor: Connector Views Engine Controls Connector End Views Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor Page 615 5. Engage the sliding latch fastening the BCM to the rear electrical center. Slide the latch outboard until the locking tab (1) is fully seated. 6. Install the rear electrical center cover. 7. If replacing the body wiring harness extension on a Chevrolet TrailBlazer or GMC Envoy, position the left hand second seat to a passenger position. 8. If replacing the body wiring harness extension on a Chevrolet TrailBlazer EXT or GMC Envoy XL, install the left second row seat. 9. Connect the negative battery cable. Page 7782 4. Once the front 2 locks are unlocked, lift the front of the dress cover and pull it forward. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the small slot on the TPA and pushing down until the TPA releases. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to angle or rock the J 38125-21 tool when inserting it into the connector or the tool may break. Insert the J 38125-21 (GM P/N 15381651-2) tool into the round canal between the terminals cavities at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to repair Micro 64 connector terminals. The Micro 64 connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-64 (M jaw) was developed to crimp Micro 64 terminals. The J 38125-64 crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. The J 38125-64 crimping tool is also designed to crimp both the wire and the insulation at the same time. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro 64 terminals. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. 1. Cut the wire as close to the damaged terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. Page 2838 available, measurements may also be clearly and legibly handwritten into the Wheel Alignment Repair Order Questionnaire attached to this bulletin. 4. Attach the Wheel Alignment Repair Order Questionnaire below along with the print-out of "Before" and "After" wheel alignment measurements to the Repair Order and retain for use by GM. Wheel Alignment Equipment and Process Wheel alignments must be performed with a quality machine that will give accurate results when performing checks. "External Reference" (image-based camera technology) is preferred. Please refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 05-00-89-029B: General Motors Dealership Critical Equipment Requirements and Recommendations. Requirements: - Computerized four wheel alignment system. - Computer capable of printing before and after alignment reports. - Computer capable of time and date stamp printout. - Racking system must have jacking capability - Racking system must be capable of level to 1.6 mm (1/16 in) - Appropriate wheel stops and safety certification - Built-in turn plates and slip plates - Wheel clamps capable of attaching to 20" or larger wheels - Racking capable of accepting any GM passenger car or light duty truck - Operator properly trained and ASE-certified (U.S. only) in wheel alignment Recommendations: Racking should have front and rear jacking capability. Equipment Maintenance and Calibration: Alignment machines must be regularly calibrated in order to give correct information. Most manufacturers recommend the following: - Alignment machines with "internal reference" sensors should be checked (and calibrated, if necessary) every six months. - Alignment machines with "external reference" (image-based camera technology) should be checked (and calibrated, if necessary) once a year. - Racks must be kept level to within 1.6 mm (1/16 in). - If any instrument that is part of the alignment machine is dropped or damaged in some way, check the calibration immediately. Check with the manufacturer of your specific equipment for their recommended service/calibration schedule. Wheel Alignment Process When performing wheel alignment measurement and/or adjustment, the following steps should be taken: Preliminary Steps: 1. Verify that the vehicle has a full tank of fuel (compensate as necessary). 2. Inspect the wheels and the tires for damage. 3. Inspect the tires for the proper inflation and irregular tire wear. 4. Inspect the wheel bearings for excessive play. 5. Inspect all suspension and steering parts for looseness, wear, or damage. 6. Inspect the steering wheel for excessive drag or poor return due to stiff or rusted linkage or suspension components. 7. Inspect the vehicle trim height. 8. Compensate for frame angle on targeted vehicles (refer to Wheel Alignment Specifications in SI). Satisfactory vehicle operation may occur over a wide range of alignment angles. However, if the wheel alignment angles are not within the range of specifications, adjust the wheel alignment to the specifications. Refer to Wheel Alignment Specifications in SI. Give consideration to excess loads, such as tool boxes, sample cases, etc. Follow the wheel alignment equipment manufacturer's instructions. Measure/Adjust: Important Prior to making any adjustments to wheel alignment on a vehicle, technicians must verify that the wheel alignment specifications loaded into their wheel alignment machine are up-to-date by comparing these to the wheel alignment specifications for the appropriate model and model year in SI. Using incorrect and/or outdated specifications may result in unnecessary adjustments, irregular and/or premature tire wear and repeat customer concerns Page 844 View of a typical Micro 64 connector. Depress the lock and pull the lever over and past the lock. Page 1727 - Yazaki has a wedge or arrow shape, similar to that shown. Delphi Connectors (Micro .64) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro 64 connectors. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. The lever lock may be located on the top or sides of the wire dress cover. Specifications Exhaust Manifold: Specifications Exhaust Manifold - Left Side/Right Side Important: Do not apply sealant to the first 3 threads of the bolt. Exhaust Manifold Bolt (5.3L) Install the exhaust manifold NEW gasket and bolts. First Pass ............................................................................................................................................. .................................................. 15 N.m (11 lb ft). Tighten the bolts beginning with the center 2 bolts. Alternate from side-to-side, and work toward the outside bolts. Final Pass ............................................................................................................................................ .................................................. 25 N.m (18 lb ft). Tighten the bolts beginning with the center 2 bolts. Alternate from side-to-side, and work toward the outside bolts. Exhaust Manifold Heat Shield Bolts ............................................................................................................................................................ 9 N.m (80 lb in) Exhaust Manifold Studs ............................................................................................. ................................................................................. 20 N.m (15 lb ft) Page 339 Step 1 - Step 3 Preliminary ProceduresRaise the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. Page 3551 Tire Pressure Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Tires - Minimizing Damage to TPM Sensors INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 08-03-10-007 Date: May 16, 2008 Subject: Minimizing Damage to Tire Pressure Monitor (TPM) Sensors During Tire Mounting/Dismounting Models: 2009 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2009 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X with Wheel Mounted Tire Pressure Sensors Minimizing Damage To TPM Sensors All GM vehicles now in production and sold in the U.S., as well as many vehicles sold in Canada, feature Tire Pressure Monitoring Systems that have valve stem mounted Tire Pressure Sensors. When dismounting and mounting tires, care must be taken when breaking the bead loose from the wheel. If the tire machines bead breaking fixture is positioned too close to the tire pressure sensor, as the tire bead breaks away from the wheel it may be forced into, or catch on the edge of the tire pressure sensor. This can damage the sensor and require the sensor to be replaced. Care must also be taken when transferring the tire bead to the other side of the wheel rim. As the tire machine rotates and the tire bead is stretched around the wheel rim, the bead can come in contact with the sensor if it is not correctly positioned in relation to the mounting/dismounting head prior to tire mounting/dismounting. This can also cause sensor damage requiring replacement. Procedure Notice: Use a tire changing machine in order to dismount tires. Do not use hand tools or tire irons alone in order to remove the tire from the wheel. Damage to the tire beads or the wheel rim could result. Notice: Do not scratch or damage the clear coating on aluminum wheels with the tire changing equipment. Scratching the clear coating could cause the aluminum wheel to corrode and the clear coating to peel from the wheel. 1. Remove the valve core from the valve stem. 2. Deflate the tire completely. Important: Rim-clamp European-type tire changers are recommended. 3. Use the tire changer in order to remove the tire from the wheel. Follow steps 4-7 to remove the tire from the wheel. 4. When separating the tire bead from the wheel position the bead breaking fixture 90, 180 and 270 degrees from the valve stem. Page 3446 Fuse Block - Rear, Bottom View Page 8153 4. Once the front 2 locks are unlocked, lift the front of the dress cover and pull it forward. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the small slot on the TPA and pushing down until the TPA releases. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to angle or rock the J 38125-21 tool when inserting it into the connector or the tool may break. Insert the J 38125-21 (GM P/N 15381651-2) tool into the round canal between the terminals cavities at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to repair Micro 64 connector terminals. The Micro 64 connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-64 (M jaw) was developed to crimp Micro 64 terminals. The J 38125-64 crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. The J 38125-64 crimping tool is also designed to crimp both the wire and the insulation at the same time. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro 64 terminals. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. 1. Cut the wire as close to the damaged terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. Page 2474 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Kostal Connectors KOSTAL CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 8831 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry one side of the nose piece up to the pre-stage position. When the nose piece is in the pre-staged position, the nose piece will be raised above the connector body the length of the step in the nose piece. 7. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry the other side of the piece to the pre-stage position. If the nose piece is higher than the first step in the nose piece, gently push down on the nose piece until it meets with resistance from the connector body, you should feel the nose piece click into position. Page 775 Engine Control Module (ECM) C1 (Pin 1 To 15) Page 236 5. Once the nose piece retainers are relaxed, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should raise slightly. 6. On the opposite side of the nose piece, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should release completely. If the nose piece does not come off, repeat the procedure on the opposite side. Page 7900 2. Connect the MDI to the Data Link Connector (DLC) of the vehicle. Note Use the USB port to make the following MDI connection: 3. Connect the MDI to a PC or laptop that has been downloaded with the GDS application from TIS2WEB. Note At least one Diagnostic Package must be installed on the PC to perform diagnostics. If GDS was just installed, select: Add New Diagnostic Package and then select: a Diagnostic Package to download. 4. Click: On the GDS icon on the PC. 5. The Login Page will appear. 6. Select: A User. 7. The ID Screen will appear. 8. Select: The serial number of the MDI being used. 9. Select: Connect. 10. Verify that the system status is ready by observing for a flashing PC light icon on the MDI. 11. Select: Make, Model and Model Year, in order to build the vehicle. 12. Click: Upload VIN, to allow the VIN to be reported to the PC. 13. At: The Verification step, turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. 14. Select: Next Action. 15. The Home Page will appear. 16. Select: Next. 17. The Diagnostic Screen will appear. Note Due to vehicle build, software and RPO variations, GDS may ask for additional information in Step 18. 18. Select: Engine ID, if prompted. 19. Select: Module Diagnostics. 20. Select: ECM. 21. Select: ID Information. 22. The Diagnostics page will appear. Typical View of GDS Calibration History Screen Note GDS is capable of displaying up to 10 Calibration History events. 23. Select: Calibration History from the drop down menu in order to display the following items on the screen: - Calibration History Buffer - Number of Calibration History Events Stored - Calibration Part Number History - Calibration Verification Number History 24. Select: Screenshot. 25. Name and save the file in an appropriate folder. 26. Select : Print, and retain a copy of the screenshot with the repair order. Page 2036 View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. View of the release tool being used for the smaller terminals. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (2-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 7794 Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. FCI Connectors FCI CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 6608 If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the DuraSeal splice sleeves. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: - Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. - Do not use the crimp and DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 to crimp DuraSeal splice sleeve. In order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 8999 Page 5950 View of connector in released position. 4. Disconnect the connector from the component. 5. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Release the rear lower half of the wiredress cover. Page 2928 Disclaimer Page 2472 2. Locate the two indents of the terminal position assurance (TPA) located on the bottom of the connector body. Page 8941 View of typical connector. View of connector in released position. 1. Locate the assist lever at the back of the connector. Move the assist lever to the rear position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the dress cover. Page 3655 Wheels: Description and Operation Steel Wheel Repair Description Steel Wheel Repair Description Notice: Do not heat wheels in an attempt to soften them for straightening or repair damage from striking curbs, etc. Do not weld wheels. The alloy used in these wheels is heat-treated and uncontrolled heating from welding affects the properties of the material. Notice: The use of tubes in tubeless tires is not a recommended repair due to the fact that speed ratings are greatly reduced. You can repair porosity in aluminum wheels. If leaks are found in a steel wheel, replace the wheel with a wheel of original equipment quality. Page 7692 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches, and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original. - The wires insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the possibility of fuel contact. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1). 5. Select the proper duraseal splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool. Refer to the Crimp and Seal Splice Table. 6. Place the duraseal splice sleeve in the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115) crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 7. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to hold the duraseal splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 8. Insert the wires into the duraseal splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel in order to prevent the wire from passing through the splice (3). 9. Close the handles of the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115), until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is applied to the splice sleeve. 10. Shrink the insulation around the splice. - Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. - Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Splicing Inline Harness Diodes SPLICING INLINE HARNESS DIODES Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure. 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode. 2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool. 5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode. Page 8275 The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors. 1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position. 4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool J 38125-10A (GM P/N 12014012-1) into the front (mating end) of the connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal through the back of the connector (2). IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector. 6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. 7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily. 10. Perform system check. Delphi Connectors (12 Way) DELPHI CONNECTORS (12-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. Page 3417 6. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by pressing on the tang. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (SENSOR) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) tool into the cavity on the lower right hand face of the connector until the terminal release tang access panel slides over. Page 6370 Release the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the blue locking tabs on both ends of the connector. Gently slide the TPA up to the released position on both ends. 6. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-13A (GM P/N 12031876-1) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. Page 4218 For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 8406 4. Once the front 2 locks are unlocked, lift the front of the dress cover and pull it forward. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the small slot on the TPA and pushing down until the TPA releases. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to angle or rock the J 38125-21 tool when inserting it into the connector or the tool may break. Insert the J 38125-21 (GM P/N 15381651-2) tool into the round canal between the terminals cavities at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to repair Micro 64 connector terminals. The Micro 64 connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-64 (M jaw) was developed to crimp Micro 64 terminals. The J 38125-64 crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. The J 38125-64 crimping tool is also designed to crimp both the wire and the insulation at the same time. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro 64 terminals. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. 1. Cut the wire as close to the damaged terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. Page 4424 3. Remove the dress cover by using a flat-blade tool to release the connector locking tabs and pulling off the dress cover. 4. Relieve the tension on the nose piece retainers by inserting J-38125-12A (12094429) into the single retainer slot on the end of the nose piece and gently prying out the locking tab. Repeat the process for both of the nose piece locking tabs on the opposite side of the nose piece. Page 5969 4. Once the front 2 locks are unlocked, lift the front of the dress cover and pull it forward. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the small slot on the TPA and pushing down until the TPA releases. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to angle or rock the J 38125-21 tool when inserting it into the connector or the tool may break. Insert the J 38125-21 (GM P/N 15381651-2) tool into the round canal between the terminals cavities at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to repair Micro 64 connector terminals. The Micro 64 connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-64 (M jaw) was developed to crimp Micro 64 terminals. The J 38125-64 crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. The J 38125-64 crimping tool is also designed to crimp both the wire and the insulation at the same time. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro 64 terminals. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. 1. Cut the wire as close to the damaged terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. Page 8532 5. Insert the J 38125-557 (GM P/N 12122378) into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 6. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Connector Position Assurance Locks CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of the connector. CPAs are used in various connectors throughout the vehicle. CPAs are also used in all SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals, of the connector. Connector Repairs CONNECTOR REPAIRS Page 1376 4. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the rear of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. 5. Once the locking tabs are unlocked, slide the inner connector out of the rear of the connector housing. Page 4177 16. Remove the upper engine wire harness retainer nut (1). 17. Reposition the upper engine wire harness aside. 18. Remove the intake manifold bolts. 19. Remove the intake manifold. Page 7125 under pressure if the radiator cap or the surge tank cap is removed while the engine and radiator are still hot. 4. Remove the surge tank fill cap from the surge tank or the coolant pressure cap from the radiator. 5. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle in SI. 6. Place a clean drain pan under the radiator drain cock or under the lower radiator hose depending on the vehicle. Refer to Cooling System Draining and Filling in SI. 7. Loosen the radiator drain cock if equipped or use J 38185 clamp pliers and reposition the clamp on the lower radiator hose at the radiator. 8. Remove the end of the lower radiator hose from the radiator. 9. Drain the engine coolant sufficiently below the level of the ECT sensor. 10. Close the radiator drain cock or connect the lower radiator hose at the radiator. 11. Use the J 38185 clamp pliers to place the clamp into the original position on the hose. 12. Lower the vehicle. 13. Disconnect the wiring harness connector from the ECT sensor (2). 14. Remove the ECT sensor (1) from the front of the cylinder head. 15. Remove the corresponding size plug at the rear of the OTHER cylinder head. 16. Coat the threads of the ECT sensor with sealer. Use GM P/N 12346004 (Canadian P/N 10953480) or an equivalent. 17. Install the ECT sensor in the hole of the cylinder head where the plug was removed. Tighten Tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb ft). 18. Coat the threads of the plug with sealer. Use GM P/N 12346004 (Canadian P/N 10953480) or an equivalent. 19. Install the plug in the hole of the cylinder head where the ECT sensor was removed Tighten Tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb ft). Important Leave enough wire attached to the ECT sensor harness connector in order to create manageable splices that are at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splice. Page 5348 9. The illustration shows a cutaway view of the connector to aid the technician in releasing the terminal retainer. 10. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Terminal Position Assurance Locks TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Tyco/Amp Connectors (CM 42-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (CM 42-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the connector body and pull the CPA out. The CPA is on the wire harness side of connector. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 8733 If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs SIR/SRS WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS, and the wiring components, such as connectors and terminals. IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system terminals. Use either an SIR/SRS pigtail or a terminated lead from the SIR Repair Kit Tray. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves, in order to repair the SIR/SRS wiring - A special crimping tool - A heat torch - An instruction manual The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides the necessary low resistance contact integrity for these sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors SIR/SRS CONNECTOR REPAIR (PLASTIC BODY AND TERMINAL METAL PIN) The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made with a special plating. This plating provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. Use the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit for repairing SIR/SRS terminals and connectors. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the repair kit. The J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit contains: Various terminated leads for sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) terminal replacement - Various connector positive assurance (CPA) locks for SIR/SRS connectors - Base of steering column pigtail connectors part number 12085514 - Yellow vinyl electrical tape Pigtail repair packs are available for SIR/SRS connectors with eight or less terminals. Only the connector body is available for connectors with more than eight terminals. The terminated leads in the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit can be used to replace damaged terminals when replacing the connector body. SIR/SRS COMPONENT WIRE PIGTAIL REPAIR IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails. A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device, not by a connector. If a wiring pigtail is damaged, you must replace the entire component, with pigtail. The inflatable restraint steering wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component. SIR/SRS WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 4891 Refer to the following table as a guide in selecting the correct test adapter for front probing connectors: Backprobe IMPORTANT: Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures. - Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector. - Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large of a test probe. - After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected, test for proper terminal contact. Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the connector. Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure SCAN TOOL SNAPSHOT PROCEDURE Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used Page 6281 Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Connector Views Engine Controls Connector End Views Mass Air Flow (MAF)/Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor Page 8507 All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system. Page 7603 Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Page 323 For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON Air Filter Element: Customer Interest Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-013B Date: February 01, 2007 INFORMATION Subject: Automatic Transmission Shift, Engine Driveability Concerns or Service Engine Soon (SES) Light On as a Result of the Use of an Excessively/Over-Oiled Aftermarket, Reusable Air Filter Models: 2007 and Prior GM Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2007 and Prior Saturn Models 2003-2007 HUMMER H2 2006-2007 HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 04-07-30-013A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle). The use of an excessively/over-oiled aftermarket, reusable air filter may result in: Service Engine Soon (SES) light on Transmission shift concerns, slipping and damaged clutch(es) or band(s) Engine driveability concerns, poor acceleration from a stop, limited engine RPM range The oil that is used on these air filter elements may be transferred onto the Mass Air Flow (MAF) sensor causing contamination of the sensor. As a result, the Grams per Second (GPS) signal from the MAF may be low and any or all of the concerns listed above may occur. When servicing a vehicle with any of these concerns, be sure to check for the presence of an aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter. The MAF, GPS reading should be compared to a like vehicle with an OEM air box and filter under the same driving conditions to verify the concern. The use of an aftermarket reusable air filter DOES NOT void the vehicle's warranty. If an aftermarket reusable air filter is used, technicians should inspect the MAF sensor element and the air induction hose for contamination of oil prior to making warranty repairs. Transmission or engine driveability concerns (related to the MAF sensor being contaminated with oil) that are the result of the use of an aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter are not considered to be warrantable repair items. Page 8988 Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Adjustments Park/Neutral Position Switch Adjustment Important: ^ The following procedure is for vehicles that have not had the switch removed or replaced. If the switch has been removed or replaced, refer to Park/Neutral Position Switch Replacement for the proper adjustment procedure. ^ Apply the parking brake. ^ The engine must start in the P (Park) or N (Neutral) positions only. ^ Check the switch for proper operation. If adjustment is required, proceed as follows: 1. Place the transmission range selector in the N (Neutral) position. 2. With an assistant in the drivers seat, raise the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 3. Loosen the park/neutral position switch mounting bolts. 4. With the vehicle in the N (Neutral) position, rotate the switch while the assistant attempts to start the engine. 5. Following a successful start, turn the engine OFF. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 6. Tighten the bolts securing the switch to the transmission. Tighten the bolts to 25 N.m (18 lb ft). 7. Lower the vehicle. 8. Check the switch for proper operation. The engine must start in the P (Park) or N (Neutral) positions only. 9. Replace the park/neutral position switch if proper operation can not be achieved. Refer to Park/Neutral Position Switch Replacement. Page 6505 Camshaft Position Sensor: Connector Views Engine Controls Connector End Views Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor Page 65 For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 7759 - A control module from another vehicle is installed. - Revised software/calibration files have been released for this vehicle. - IMPORTANT: DO NOT re-program the control module with the SAME software/calibration files that are already present in the control module. This is not an effective repair for any type of concern. Verify that the control module contains the correct software/calibration. If incorrect programming is found, reprogram the control module with the most current software/calibration. Refer to Control Module References for replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Testing for Short to Ground TESTING FOR SHORT TO GROUND NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 4. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit. With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is a short to ground in the circuit. Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2. Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). - When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. - If the DMM does not display voltage 4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is shorted. Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A DIGITAL MULTIMETER NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the powertrain control module (PCM), should only be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200 Digital Multimeter (DMM). The J 39200 instruction manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminage even though voltage is present. The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity. IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading. Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the measurement. Page 419 7. Pressing the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool in the release cavity of the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and crimper in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (DOOR MODULE) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Side view of connector. View of top of connector. 1. Locate the assist lever and lock on the top of the connector. Page 8784 - A control module from another vehicle is installed. - Revised software/calibration files have been released for this vehicle. - IMPORTANT: DO NOT re-program the control module with the SAME software/calibration files that are already present in the control module. This is not an effective repair for any type of concern. Verify that the control module contains the correct software/calibration. If incorrect programming is found, reprogram the control module with the most current software/calibration. Refer to Control Module References for replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Testing for Short to Ground TESTING FOR SHORT TO GROUND NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 4. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit. With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is a short to ground in the circuit. Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2. Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). - When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. - If the DMM does not display voltage 4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is shorted. Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A DIGITAL MULTIMETER NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the powertrain control module (PCM), should only be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200 Digital Multimeter (DMM). The J 39200 instruction manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminage even though voltage is present. The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity. IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading. Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the measurement. Page 3800 If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the DuraSeal splice sleeves. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: - Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. - Do not use the crimp and DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 to crimp DuraSeal splice sleeve. In order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 768 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches, and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original. - The wires insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the possibility of fuel contact. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1). 5. Select the proper duraseal splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool. Refer to the Crimp and Seal Splice Table. 6. Place the duraseal splice sleeve in the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115) crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 7. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to hold the duraseal splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 8. Insert the wires into the duraseal splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel in order to prevent the wire from passing through the splice (3). 9. Close the handles of the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115), until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is applied to the splice sleeve. 10. Shrink the insulation around the splice. - Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. - Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Splicing Inline Harness Diodes SPLICING INLINE HARNESS DIODES Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure. 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode. 2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool. 5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode. Page 2853 If the thrust angle is not set properly the vehicle may "dog track";, the steering wheel may not be centered or it could be perceived as a bent axle. Thrust angle can be checked during a wheel alignment. Positive thrust angle means the thrust line is pointing to the right hand side (RHS) of the vehicle. Negative thrust angle means the thrust line is pointing to the left hand side (LHS) of the vehicle. If the thrust angle is out of specification, moving the axle to body relationship will change the thrust angle reading. If the vehicle is out in the Positive (+) direction-moving the RHS forward and/or LHS rearward will move the thrust angle towards zero degrees. If the vehicle is out in the Negative (-) direction-moving the RHS rearward and/or LHS forward will move the thrust angle towards zero degrees. Lead/Pull Description Lead/Pull Description At a constant highway speed on a typical straight road, lead/pull is the amount of effort required at the steering wheel to maintain the vehicle's straight path. Important: Vehicles will tend to lead/pull in the direction of the road slope as part of normal operation. Lead/pull is usually caused by the following factors: ^ Road slope ^ Variability in tire construction ^ Wheel alignment (front cross caster and camber) ^ Unbalanced steering gear ^ Electronic Power Steering (EPS) steering position and torque sensors not calibrated correctly, if equipped. Memory Steer Description Memory Steer Description Memory steer is when the vehicle wants to lead or pull in the direction the driver previously turned the vehicle. Additionally, after turning in the opposite direction, the vehicle will want to lead or pull in that direction. Wander Description Wander Description Wander is the undesired drifting or deviation of a vehicle to either side from a straight path with hand pressure on the steering wheel. Wander is a symptom of the vehicle's sensitivity to external disturbances, such as road crown and crosswind, and accentuated by poor on-center steering feel. Scrub Radius Description Scrub Radius Description Ideally, the scrub radius is as small as possible. Normally, the SAI angle and the centerline of the tire and the wheel intersect below the road surface, causing a positive scrub radius. With struts, the SAI angle is much larger than the long arm/short arm type of suspension. This allows the SAI angle to intersect the camber angle above the road surface, forming a negative scrub radius. The smaller the scrub radius, the better the directional stability. Installing aftermarket wheels that have additional offset will dramatically increase the scrub radius. The newly installed wheels may cause the centerline of the tires to move further away from the spindle. This will increase the scrub radius. A large amount of scrub radius can cause severe shimmy after hitting a bump. Four-wheel drive vehicles with large tires use a steering damper to compensate for an increased scrub radius. Scrub radius is not directly measurable by the conventional methods. Scrub radius is projected geometrically by engineers during the design phase of the suspension. Page 6500 6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias. Reference the appropriate service manual wiring schematic to obtain the correct diode installation position. 7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for the soldering equipment. 8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed. 9. IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode attachment points with tape. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape. Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable SPLICING TWISTED OR SHIELDED CABLE Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable. 1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splice is made. 3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire. Staggering the splices by 65 mm (2.5 in) is recommended. 4. IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical contact with the drain wire. Re-assemble the cable. Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape. - Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1). - Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire. - Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape. Page 1347 pulling it through. This will prevent damage to the internal seals of the connector. Once the terminal is pushed out of the connector, cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible and pull the wire through the connector. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE The Micro-Pack 100W connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool was developed to crimp Micro-Pack 100W terminals. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 2. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert the terminal into the crimp tool until the core wings are flush with the anvil on the crimp tool. Be sure that the wings are pointed toward the crimp tool former and release the spring locator. The locator will hold the terminal in place. Inspect the alignment of the terminal wings with the crimp tool former. If the terminal wings are wider than the crimp tool former, remove the terminal and bend the terminal wings in slightly. 5. Place stripped wire into terminal. 6. Crimp the new terminal to the wire. If a jam occurs, press the emergency release to open applicator. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire perform the following procedure in order to replace Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. Page 3269 7. Apply pressure and gently rock the cover until one locking leg is unseated. 8. Continue to apply pressure and rock the cover until the second locking leg is unseated. Repeat procedure for the other side of the dress cover and remove the cover. 9. Use J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) to gently lift the terminal retaining tab while gently pulling the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 10. If the terminal is severely bent or damaged, it may be possible on some connectors to push the wire out of the front of the connector instead of Page 8912 5. Insert the J 38125-557 (GM P/N 12122378) into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 6. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Connector Position Assurance Locks CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of the connector. CPAs are used in various connectors throughout the vehicle. CPAs are also used in all SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals, of the connector. Connector Repairs CONNECTOR REPAIRS Page 8859 If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs SIR/SRS WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS, and the wiring components, such as connectors and terminals. IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system terminals. Use either an SIR/SRS pigtail or a terminated lead from the SIR Repair Kit Tray. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves, in order to repair the SIR/SRS wiring - A special crimping tool - A heat torch - An instruction manual The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides the necessary low resistance contact integrity for these sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors SIR/SRS CONNECTOR REPAIR (PLASTIC BODY AND TERMINAL METAL PIN) The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made with a special plating. This plating provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. Use the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit for repairing SIR/SRS terminals and connectors. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the repair kit. The J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit contains: Various terminated leads for sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) terminal replacement - Various connector positive assurance (CPA) locks for SIR/SRS connectors - Base of steering column pigtail connectors part number 12085514 - Yellow vinyl electrical tape Pigtail repair packs are available for SIR/SRS connectors with eight or less terminals. Only the connector body is available for connectors with more than eight terminals. The terminated leads in the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit can be used to replace damaged terminals when replacing the connector body. SIR/SRS COMPONENT WIRE PIGTAIL REPAIR IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails. A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device, not by a connector. If a wiring pigtail is damaged, you must replace the entire component, with pigtail. The inflatable restraint steering wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component. SIR/SRS WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 273 Driver Door Module (DDM) C3 (Outside Rearview Mirror - Driver) (DS3/DL2) Page 7091 The engine harness may be repaired using the J-38125. High Temperature Wiring Repairs HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperatures, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time may use materials i.e. wires, connectors, and shielding that has a higher heat rating than typical wiring. When making a repair in a high temperature area observe the following: Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature to replace any damaged wire. - Replace any heat shielding that is removed. - Cover any DuraSeal splice sleeves with SCT1 shrink tubing (available in the J-38125 Terminal Repair kit). - After making a wiring repair, ensure that the location of the wiring is not moved closer to the heat source. IDENTIFYING HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperature, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time need special considerations when making wiring repairs. Areas that may be exposed to higher temperatures can be identified by heat resistant materials that are being used in those areas. These materials may include heat reflective tape, moon tape, and high temperature shrink tubing. Also conduit and other protective coverings may be used. Because conduit or similar coverings are used throughout the vehicle regardless of the temperature, it may be necessary for the technician to determine if an area is exposed to excessive heat before making a wiring repair. Obvious areas of consideration would be any area located near the exhaust manifolds, catalytic converter, and exhaust pipes. The J-38125 contains much of the material you will need to perform repairs on areas exposed to high heat. The kit contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves to crimp and seal connections - High temperature SCT1 shrink tubing to protect the splice sleeves - A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct crimp tool to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools to remove the terminals from the connectors The J-38125 does not contain wire that is suitable to high temperature exposure. Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature of the same or larger gage size as the original wire when repair damage wire. Also replace any reflective tape that you remove during the repair. HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature rating of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125 and then encapsulate the splice sleeve using the high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the order listed. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip keeping all of the wire strands intact. Page 2322 Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. For connectors with a bolt in the dress cover, turn the bolt counterclockwise to remove the connector from the component. 2. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. Page 5147 All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system. Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair Grounding Point: All Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 10-08-45-001B Date: October 25, 2010 Subject: Information for Electrical Ground Repair - Use New Replacement Fasteners with Conductive Finish Models: 2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2011 model year and update the Warranty Information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 10-08-45-001A (Section 08 - Body and Accessories). Electrical Ground Repair Overview Proper electrical system function relies on secure, stable and corrosion-free electrical ground connections. Loose, stripped, or corroded connections increase the possibility of improper system function and loss of module communication. These conditions may also lead to unnecessary repairs and component replacement. In general, electrical ground connections are accomplished using one, or a combination of the following attachment methods: - Welded M6 stud and nut - Welded M6 nut and bolt - Welded M8 nut and bolt Determine which attachment method is used and perform the appropriate or alternative repair as described in this bulletin. M6 Weld Stud Replacement Caution Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground repair. 1. Select a location adjacent the damaged or missing M6 ground stud having 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance behind the panel surface and 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance surrounding the M6 conductive rivet stud flange. 2. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the repair site and allow to dry. Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled. 3. Drill a 10 mm (0.40 in) diameter hole through the panel. 4. Remove paint and primer from the area surrounding the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole until bare metal is visible. Page 4958 View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. View of the release tool being used for the smaller terminals. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (2-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 7569 Body Control System Diagram 1 (3 Of 3) Page 4603 IMPORTANT: Ensure that the dress cover and connector body are both in the released position before reassembling. Failure to do so may cause damage to the connector and component. Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (0.64) BOSCH CONNECTORS (0.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While pressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock until the lever is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Pull the rubber boot that covers the wires back to expose the end of the connector dress cover. 4. Place the connector locking lever in the center of the connector. 5. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs that are on the wire end of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover and connector body and pry up. Page 5399 Page 7599 Utility/Van Zoning UTILITY/VAN ZONING Page 3757 Release the lower wiredress cover locking tab. Release the upper wiredress cover locking tab. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. Page 863 2. Locate the two indents of the terminal position assurance (TPA) located on the bottom of the connector body. Page 204 - Yazaki has a wedge or arrow shape, similar to that shown. Delphi Connectors (Micro .64) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro 64 connectors. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. The lever lock may be located on the top or sides of the wire dress cover. Page 2135 2. Locate the two indents of the terminal position assurance (TPA) located on the bottom of the connector body. Page 7361 2. Locate the nose piece locking tabs that are positioned on the side of the connector nose piece. The connector nose piece acts as a terminal positive assurance (TPA) and may be referred to as such. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to push in one of the locking tabs while gently pulling on the same side of the nose piece. 4. Repeat the procedure for the other locking tab and remove the nose piece. 5. Remove the wire dress cover. The following is a general procedure for wire dress cover removal. Use this procedure as a guide, some dress cover removal procedures may vary. 6. Use fingers to squeeze the 2 locking legs of the cover. Page 7764 Release the tabs that are holding the wiredress cover to the connector body. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the slots on both ends of the connector body. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. J 38125-216 can also be used to remove the nose piece. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by lifting the terminal retaining tabs on the inside of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 2149 9. The illustration shows a cutaway view of the connector to aid the technician in releasing the terminal retainer. 10. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Terminal Position Assurance Locks TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Tyco/Amp Connectors (CM 42-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (CM 42-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the connector body and pull the CPA out. The CPA is on the wire harness side of connector. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 2687 1 - Inflatable Restraint Seat Position Sensor (SPS) - Right 2 - Seat Recline Motor - Passenger (V40) 3 - Seat Rear Vertical Motor - Passenger (V40) 4 - Seat Front Vertical Motor - Passenger (V40) 4 - 5 - Seat Horizontal Motor - Passenger (V40) Page 5143 Page 2004 The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors. 1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position. 4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool J 38125-10A (GM P/N 12014012-1) into the front (mating end) of the connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal through the back of the connector (2). IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector. 6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. 7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily. 10. Perform system check. Delphi Connectors (12 Way) DELPHI CONNECTORS (12-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. Page 2277 breakers are used. CIRCUIT BREAKER This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high current is removed. POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) CIRCUIT BREAKER This type greatly increases its resistance when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker will re-close within a second or 2. Circuit Protection - Fuses CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSES The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and examine the element in the fuse for an open (2). If not broken (1), also check for continuity using a DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one of equal current rating. Circuit Protection - Fusible Links CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSIBLE LINKS Heated Oxygen and Oxygen Sensor Notice Oxygen Sensor: Service Precautions Heated Oxygen and Oxygen Sensor Notice Heated Oxygen and Oxygen Sensor Notice Notice: Do not remove the pigtail from either the heated oxygen sensor (HO2S) or the oxygen sensor (O2S). Removing the pigtail or the connector will affect sensor operation. Handle the oxygen sensor carefully. Do not drop the HO2S. Keep the in-line electrical connector and the louvered end free of grease, dirt, or other contaminants. Do not use cleaning solvents of any type. Do not repair the wiring, connector or terminals. Replace the oxygen sensor if the pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged. This external clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors, or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degraded sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: * Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. * Do not damage the sensor pigtail and harness wires in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. * Ensure the sensor or vehicle lead wires are not bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends or kinks could block the reference air path through the lead wire. * Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire, where applicable. Vehicles that utilize the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will cause poor engine performance. * Ensure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector in order to prevent damage due to water intrusion. The engine harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air reference being obstructed. Page 8571 7. The illustration above identifies the entry canal where the terminal release tool will be inserted, and the terminal cavity. - Terminal (1) - Entry Canal (2) 8. Insert the J-38125-553 (15315247) tool into the entry canal and pry up on the terminal retainer. The terminal retainer is a small plastic piece on the top of the terminal. The terminal retainer must be held up while the terminal is pulled out of the connector. Page 3126 3. Inspect the rear axle for leaks. Repair as necessary. 4. Clean the area around the rear axle fill plug. 5. Remove the rear axle fill plug. 6. Fabricate a dipstick from a pipe cleaner or similar item. Form the pipe cleaner into the shape of an "L";. Important: Ensure that the pipe cleaner is resting on the bottom threads of the fill hole. 7. Insert the pipe cleaner into the fill plug opening with the stem "L"; is facing down. 8. Inspect the lubricant level. The lubricant level should be between 0-10 mm (0-0.4 in) below the fill plug opening. 9. If the fluid level is low, add lubricant until the level is even with the bottom edge of the fill plug opening. Use the proper fluid. Refer to Fluid and Lubricant Recommendations. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 10. Install the rear axle fill plug. Tighten the rear axle fill plug to 33 N.m (24 lb ft). 11. Lower the vehicle. Page 6743 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link). - The wire insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. 5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold them between thumb and forefinger. 7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place. - Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction. - Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip. 8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool closes.Ensure that no strands of wire are cut. 10. Crimp the splice on each end (2). Page 7532 7. The illustration above identifies the entry canal where the terminal release tool will be inserted, and the terminal cavity. - Terminal (1) - Entry Canal (2) 8. Insert the J-38125-553 (15315247) tool into the entry canal and pry up on the terminal retainer. The terminal retainer is a small plastic piece on the top of the terminal. The terminal retainer must be held up while the terminal is pulled out of the connector. Page 4134 Oil Pan: Service and Repair Oil Pan Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. Refer to Battery Negative Cable Disconnection and Connection. 2. Remove the oil level indicator tube. Refer to Oil Level Indicator and Tube Replacement. 3. Remove the front differential and secure to the frame. Refer to Differential Carrier Assembly Replacement (4.2L In-Line Six Cylinder) Differential Carrier Assembly Replacement (V8). 4. Drain the engine oil. Refer to Engine Oil and Oil Filter Replacement. 5. Remove the transmission oil cooler lines (1) from the retainer (2). Page 3572 of vibration is normally felt more in the "seat of the pants" than the steering wheel. 5. Next, record the Hertz (Hz) reading as displayed by the EVA onto the tire data worksheet found at the end of this bulletin. This should be done after a tire break-in period of at least 16 km (10 mi) at 72 km/h (45 mph) or greater, in order to eliminate any possible tire flat-spotting. This reading confirms what the vehicle vibration frequency is prior to vehicle service and documents the amount of improvement occurring as the result of the various steps taken to repair. Completing the Steering Wheel Shake Worksheet below is required. A copy of the completed worksheet must be saved with the R.O. and a copy included with any parts returned to the Warranty Parts Center for analysis. A reading of 35 to 50 Hz typically indicates a first order propshaft vibration. If this is the situation, refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 08-07-30-044D. Generally, a reading between 10 and 20 Hz indicates a tire/wheel vibration and if this is the reading obtained, continue using this bulletin. If the tire 1st order vibration goes away and stays away during this evaluation, the cause is likely tire flat-spotting. Tire flat-spotting vibration may come and go at any speed over 72 km/h (45 mph) during the first 10 minutes of operation, if vibration continues after 10 minutes of driving at speeds greater than 72 km/h (45 mph), tire flat-spotting can be ruled out as the cause for vibration. 6. If flat-spotting is the cause, provide the explanation that this has occurred due to the vehicle being parked for long periods of time and that the nature of the tire is to take a set. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 03-03-10-007E: Information on Tire/Wheel Characteristics (Vibration, Balance, Shake, Flat Spotting) of GM Original Equipment Tires. 7. If the road test indicates a shake/vibration exists, check the imbalance of each tire/wheel assembly on a known, calibrated, off-car dynamic balancer.Make sure the mounting surface of the wheel and the surface of the balancer are absolutely clean and free of debris. Be sure to chose the proper cone/collet for the wheel, and always use the pilot bore for centering. Never center the wheel using the hub-cap bore since it is not a precision machined surface. If any assembly calls for more than 1/4 ounce on either rim flange, remove all balance weights and rebalance to as close to zero as possible. If you can see the vibration (along with feeling it) in the steering wheel (driving straight without your hands on the wheel), it is very likely to be a tire/wheel first order (one pulse per revolution) disturbance. First order disturbances can be caused by imbalance as well as non-uniformities in tires, wheels or hubs. This first order frequency is too low for a human to hear, but if the amplitude is high enough, it can be seen. If a vibration or shake still exists after balancing, any out of round conditions, of the wheel, and force variation conditions of the tire, must be addressed. Equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700 can address both (it is also a wheel balancer). Tire radial force vibration (RFV) can be defined as the amount of stiffness variation the tire will produce in one revolution under a constant load. Radial force variation is what the vehicle feels because the load (weight) of the vehicle is always on the tires. Although free runout of tires (not under load) is not always a good indicator of a smooth ride, it is critical that total tire/wheel assembly runout be within specification. Equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700 loads the tire, similar to on the vehicle, and measures radial force variation of the tire/wheel assembly. Note that the wheel is affecting the tire's RFV measurement at this point. To isolate the wheel, its runout must be measured. This can be easily done on the Hunter, without the need to set up dial indicators. If the wheel meets the runout specification, the tire's RFV can then be addressed. After measuring the tire/wheel assembly under load, and the wheel alone, the machine then calculates (predicts) the radial force variation of the tire. However, because this is a prediction that can include mounting inaccuracies, and the load wheel is much smaller in diameter than used in tire production, this type of service equipment should NOT be used to audit new tires. Rather, it should be used as a service diagnostic tool to minimize radial force variation of the tire/wheel assembly. Equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700 does an excellent job of measuring wheel runout, and of finding the low point of the wheel (for runout) and the high point of the tire (for radial force variation). This allows the tire to be matched mounted to the wheel for lowest tire/wheel assembly force variation. The machine will simplify this process into easy steps. The following assembly radial force variation numbers should be used as a guide: When measuring RFV and match mounting tires perform the following steps. Measuring Wheel Runout and Assembly Radial Force Variation Important The completed worksheet at the end of this bulletin must be attached to the hard copy of the repair order. - Measure radial force variation and radial runout. - If a road force/balancing machine is used, record the radial force variation (RFV) on the worksheet at the end of this bulletin. It may be of benefit to have the lowest RFV assembly to the front left corner. If the machine is not available and the EVA data suggests there is an issue, swap the tire and wheel assemblies from the front to the back. Re-check on the EVA and if the problem still exists, test another vehicle to find tires that do not exhibit the same frequency and swap those tires onto the subject vehicle. - If a runout/balancing machine is used, record the radial runout of the tire/wheel assemblies on the worksheet at the end of this bulletin. If one or more of the tire/wheel assemblies are more than.040 in (1.02 mm), match mount the tire to the wheel to get below.040 in (1.02 mm). For sensitive customers, readings of 0.030 inch (0.76 mm) or less are preferable, it may also be of benefit to have the lowest runout assembly to the front left corner. If the machine is not available and the EVA data suggests there is an issue, swap the tire and wheel assemblies from the front to the back. Re-check on the EVA and if the problem still exists, test another vehicle to find tires that do not exhibit the same frequency and swap those tires Page 1700 Checking Aftermarket Accessories CHECKING AFTERMARKET ACCESSORIES Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits: - CAUTION: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol. - NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice. OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol. Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the cause of the problems. Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include: Power feeds connected to points other than the battery - Antenna location - Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring - Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line - Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories. Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions INDUCING INTERMITTENT FAULT CONDITIONS TOOLS REQUIRED J 25070 Heat Gun Many intermittent open or shorted circuits are affected by harness/connector movement that is caused by vibration, engine torque, bumps/rough pavement, etc. In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness if the malfunction appears to be Page 4442 breakers are used. CIRCUIT BREAKER This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high current is removed. POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) CIRCUIT BREAKER This type greatly increases its resistance when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker will re-close within a second or 2. Circuit Protection - Fuses CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSES The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and examine the element in the fuse for an open (2). If not broken (1), also check for continuity using a DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one of equal current rating. Circuit Protection - Fusible Links CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSIBLE LINKS Page 8411 pulling it through. This will prevent damage to the internal seals of the connector. Once the terminal is pushed out of the connector, cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible and pull the wire through the connector. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE The Micro-Pack 100W connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool was developed to crimp Micro-Pack 100W terminals. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 2. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert the terminal into the crimp tool until the core wings are flush with the anvil on the crimp tool. Be sure that the wings are pointed toward the crimp tool former and release the spring locator. The locator will hold the terminal in place. Inspect the alignment of the terminal wings with the crimp tool former. If the terminal wings are wider than the crimp tool former, remove the terminal and bend the terminal wings in slightly. 5. Place stripped wire into terminal. 6. Crimp the new terminal to the wire. If a jam occurs, press the emergency release to open applicator. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire perform the following procedure in order to replace Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. Page 8973 11. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 12. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 13. Center the high temperature SCT1 shrink tube over the DuraSeal splice sleeve. 14. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the high temperature heat shrink tubing. 15. Gradually move the heat from the center to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 16. Replace any reflective tape and clips that may have been remove during the repair. Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation REPAIRING DAMAGED WIRE INSULATION Wire Size Conversion Page 8970 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Start in the middle and gradually move the heat barrel to the open ends of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Heated Oxygen Sensor Wiring Repairs HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being obstructed. If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. - Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks, etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire. - Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance. - To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector. Page 5192 Release the lower wiredress cover locking tab. Release the upper wiredress cover locking tab. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. Page 2195 Page 2691 14. Remove the 4 nuts (1) securing the seat cushion frame to the seat adjusters. 15. Remove the seat adjusters. 16. Remove the 2 nuts (1) securing the seat position switch (3) to the seat adjuster (2). 17. Drill out the rivets securing the sensor to the bracket. Installation Procedure 1. Install new rivets securing the sensor to the bracket. Page 1794 Knock Sensor: Connector Views Engine Controls Connector End Views Knock Sensor (KS) 1 - Left Knock Sensor (KS) 2 - Right Page 4770 Page 4395 View of the connector when released from the component. View of another type of Micro 64 connector. Page 7517 4. Use a small flat-blade tool to slide the terminal position assurance (TPA) up one notch on both ends of the connector. The TPA is located underneath the wire dress cover. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 7348 5. Insert the J 38125-557 (GM P/N 12122378) into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 6. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Connector Position Assurance Locks CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of the connector. CPAs are used in various connectors throughout the vehicle. CPAs are also used in all SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals, of the connector. Connector Repairs CONNECTOR REPAIRS Page 8661 3. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. View showing depressing of the lever lock release tab. Page 7441 1. Install the fuel level sensor (2) and electrical connector (1) to the fuel sender assembly. 2. Connect the fuel level sensor electrical connector (1). 3. Ensure the fuel level sensor retaining tabs (2) are fully engaged. 4. Install the fuel sender assembly. Page 8696 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. JST Connectors JST CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, remove the connector from the component. Page 2348 pulling it through. This will prevent damage to the internal seals of the connector. Once the terminal is pushed out of the connector, cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible and pull the wire through the connector. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE The Micro-Pack 100W connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool was developed to crimp Micro-Pack 100W terminals. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 2. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert the terminal into the crimp tool until the core wings are flush with the anvil on the crimp tool. Be sure that the wings are pointed toward the crimp tool former and release the spring locator. The locator will hold the terminal in place. Inspect the alignment of the terminal wings with the crimp tool former. If the terminal wings are wider than the crimp tool former, remove the terminal and bend the terminal wings in slightly. 5. Place stripped wire into terminal. 6. Crimp the new terminal to the wire. If a jam occurs, press the emergency release to open applicator. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire perform the following procedure in order to replace Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. Page 6388 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches, and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original. - The wires insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the possibility of fuel contact. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1). 5. Select the proper duraseal splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool. Refer to the Crimp and Seal Splice Table. 6. Place the duraseal splice sleeve in the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115) crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 7. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to hold the duraseal splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 8. Insert the wires into the duraseal splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel in order to prevent the wire from passing through the splice (3). 9. Close the handles of the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115), until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is applied to the splice sleeve. 10. Shrink the insulation around the splice. - Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. - Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Splicing Inline Harness Diodes SPLICING INLINE HARNESS DIODES Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure. 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode. 2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool. 5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode. Page 8419 REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. The release tab is located on the top of the wiredress cover. View of connector in released position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Page 6316 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. 4. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front of the connector. Page 4935 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully raise the TPA on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA cannot be removed from the connector while there are terminals present in the connector body. View of the TPA when removed from the connector body. 4. Use the J 38125-12A tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the left side of the terminal release cavity as shown in the graphic. Use the tool to move the terminal release to the right with a gentle prying motion. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 5301 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (BSK) BOSCH CONNECTORS (BSK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 3. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 4. Insert the J 38125-561 tool into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 5. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is Page 6469 3. Remove the dress cover by using a flat-blade tool to release the connector locking tabs and pulling off the dress cover. 4. Relieve the tension on the nose piece retainers by inserting J-38125-12A (12094429) into the single retainer slot on the end of the nose piece and gently prying out the locking tab. Repeat the process for both of the nose piece locking tabs on the opposite side of the nose piece. Diagram Information and Instructions Fuel Pump Relay: Diagram Information and Instructions Electrical Symbols Page 9068 3. Use a small flat-bladed tool to gently pry off the dress cover by inserting the tool under the cover opposite the harness side and prying up. 4. Remove the cover. 5. Using a small flat-bladed tool, push on the side of the nose piece retainer while pushing the nose piece forward with your thumb. This will release the terminal position assurance (TPA). 6. Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) into the corresponding terminal release cavity. The release cavities are the 2 center rows of cavities on one half of the connector. Page 8738 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches, and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original. - The wires insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the possibility of fuel contact. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1). 5. Select the proper duraseal splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool. Refer to the Crimp and Seal Splice Table. 6. Place the duraseal splice sleeve in the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115) crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 7. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to hold the duraseal splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 8. Insert the wires into the duraseal splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel in order to prevent the wire from passing through the splice (3). 9. Close the handles of the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115), until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is applied to the splice sleeve. 10. Shrink the insulation around the splice. - Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. - Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Splicing Inline Harness Diodes SPLICING INLINE HARNESS DIODES Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure. 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode. 2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool. 5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode. Page 1328 5. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove TPA from the connector. 6. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Fuel Level Sensor Replacement Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair Fuel Level Sensor Replacement Fuel Level Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Remove the fuel sender assembly. 2. Disconnect the fuel level sensor electrical connector (1). 3. Depress the fuel level sensor retaining tabs (2) to release the sensor from the sender assembly. 4. Remove the fuel level sensor electrical connector (1) and sensor (2) from the fuel sender assembly. Installation Procedure Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules Wiring Harness: All Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 09-06-03-004D Date: December 08, 2010 Subject: Intermittent No Crank/No Start, No Module Communication, MIL, Warning Lights, Vehicle Messages or DTCs Set by Various Control Modules - Diagnosing and Repairing Fretting Corrosion (Disconnect Affected Connector and Apply Dielectric Lubricant) Models: 2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks Attention: This repair can be applied to ANY electrical connection including, but not limited to: lighting, body electrical, in-line connections, powertrain control sensors, etc. DO NOT over apply lubricant to the point where it prevents the full engagement of sealed connectors. A light coating on the terminal surfaces is sufficient to correct the condition. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the Attention statement and add the 2011 model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 09-06-03-004C (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System). Condition Some customers may comment on any of the following conditions: - An intermittent no crank/no start - Intermittent malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) illumination - Intermittent service lamp illumination - Intermittent service message(s) being displayed The technician may determine that he is unable to duplicate the intermittent condition. Cause This condition may be caused by a buildup of nonconductive insulating oxidized debris known as fretting corrosion, occurring between two electrical contact surfaces of the connection or connector. This may be caused by any of the following conditions: - Vibration - Thermal cycling - Poor connection/terminal retention - Micro motion - A connector, component or wiring harness not properly secured resulting in movement On low current signal circuits this condition may cause high resistance, resulting in intermittent connections. On high current power circuits this condition may cause permanent increases in the resistance and may cause a device to become inoperative. Representative List of Control Modules and Components The following is only a representative list of control modules and components that may be affected by this connection or connector condition and DOES NOT include every possible module or component for every vehicle. - Blower Control Module - Body Control Module (BCM) - Communication Interface Module (CIM) - Cooling Fan Control Module - Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM) - Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module (EBTCM) - Electronic Suspension Control (ESC) Module - Engine Control Module (ECM) - Heating, Ventilation and Air Conditioning (HVAC) Control Module Page 1185 Low Pressure Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair Air Conditioning (A/C) Low Pressure Switch Replacement Tools Required J39400-A Halogen Leak Detector Removal Procedure 1. Disconnect the A/C low pressure switch electrical connector. 2. Remove the A/C low pressure switch (2) from the accumulator (1). 3. Remove and discard the O-ring seal from the A/C low pressure switch port on the accumulator. Installation Procedure 1. Install the new O-ring seal. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Install the A/C low pressure switch (2) to the accumulator (1). Tighten the A/C low pressure switch to 4.8 N.m (42 lb in). 3. Connect the A/C low pressure switch electrical connector. 4. Leak test the fittings of the components using the J39400-A. Page 8226 Page 8306 Release the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the blue locking tabs on both ends of the connector. Gently slide the TPA up to the released position on both ends. 6. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-13A (GM P/N 12031876-1) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. Page 1049 Power Seat Motor Position Sensor: Diagrams Seat Position Sensor Seat Position Sensor - Front (w/Memory) Page 2930 Drive Belt: Description and Operation Drive Belt System Description The drive belt system consists of the following components: ^ The drive belt ^ The drive belt tensioner ^ The drive belt idler pulley ^ The crankshaft balancer pulley ^ The accessory drive component mounting brackets ^ The accessory drive components The power steering pump, if belt driven - The generator - The A/C compressor, if equipped - The engine cooling fan, if belt driven - The water pump, if belt driven - The vacuum pump, if equipped - The air compressor, if equipped The drive belt system may use 1 belt or 2 belts. The drive belt is thin so that it can bend backwards and has several ribs to match the grooves in the pulleys. There also may be a V-belt style belt used to drive certain accessory drive components. The drive belts are made of different types of rubbers - chloroprene or EPDM - and have different layers or plies containing either fiber cloth or cords for reinforcement. Both sides of the drive belt may be used to drive the different accessory drive components. When the back side of the drive belt is used to drive a pulley, the pulley is smooth. The drive belt is pulled by the crankshaft balancer pulley across the accessory drive component pulleys. The spring loaded drive belt tensioner keeps constant tension on the drive belt to prevent the drive belt from slipping. The drive belt tensioner arm will move when loads are applied to the drive belt by the accessory drive components and the crankshaft. The drive belt system may have an idler pulley, which is used to add wrap to the adjacent pulleys. Some systems use an idler pulley in place of an accessory drive component when the vehicle is not equipped with the accessory. Page 457 Engine - Low Oil Lamp ON/Oil Leaks Oil Pressure Sensor: Customer Interest Engine - Low Oil Lamp ON/Oil Leaks TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 07-06-01-004A Date: November 25, 2008 Subject: All Vortec(R) GEN IV V8 Engines - LY2 LS4 LC9 LH6 LMG LY5 LS2 L76 LY6 L92 LS7, Low Oil Level Indicator Lamp On and/or Engine Oil Leak (Reseal Oil Pressure Sensor) Models Supercede: This bulletin is being updated to include a labor operation number for CTS-V and Corvette models. Please discard Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 07-06-01-004 (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System). Condition Some customers may comment on a low oil level indicator lamp on and/or engine oil leak. Upon further investigation, the technician may find that the oil leak is at the oil pressure sensor that is threaded into the valve lifter oil manifold (VLOM) assembly and/or engine valley cover. Correction If the engine oil leak was found to be at the engine oil pressure sensor, then remove the oil pressure sensor and reseal with a pipe sealant with Teflon or equivalent, P/N 12346004 (in Canada, P/N 10953480). Refer to Engine Oil Pressure Sensor and/or Switch Replacement in SI. Parts Information Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models) Page 9074 2. Use a small flat-bladed tool to release the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting the tool in the small recess on the side of the connector and pushing up until the TPA releases from the connector body. The TPA should raise just slightly. Do not try to remove the TPA. IMPORTANT: The TPA on this connector cannot be removed unless the terminals are removed first. The TPA will come out of the connector body, but only slightly. When the TPA is slightly raised the terminals can be removed. Using excessive force to remove the TPA with the terminals still in the connector will damage the connector. 3. Repeat the process for the other side of the connector. 4. Ensure that the TPA is in the proper position to remove the terminals. Page 6950 breakers are used. CIRCUIT BREAKER This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high current is removed. POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) CIRCUIT BREAKER This type greatly increases its resistance when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker will re-close within a second or 2. Circuit Protection - Fuses CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSES The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and examine the element in the fuse for an open (2). If not broken (1), also check for continuity using a DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one of equal current rating. Circuit Protection - Fusible Links CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSIBLE LINKS Page 1615 4. Slide the dress cover forward and off of the connector. 5. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front and rear of the connector. Page 1136 Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Install the ECT sensor. Tighten the sensor to 20 N.m (15 lb ft). 3. Connect the ECT sensor electrical connector (1). 4. Refill the engine coolant. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System (LL8) Draining and Filling Cooling System (LH6, LS2). Page 5410 Checking Aftermarket Accessories CHECKING AFTERMARKET ACCESSORIES Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits: - CAUTION: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol. - NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice. OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol. Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the cause of the problems. Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include: Power feeds connected to points other than the battery - Antenna location - Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring - Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line - Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories. Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions INDUCING INTERMITTENT FAULT CONDITIONS TOOLS REQUIRED J 25070 Heat Gun Many intermittent open or shorted circuits are affected by harness/connector movement that is caused by vibration, engine torque, bumps/rough pavement, etc. In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness if the malfunction appears to be Page 1748 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully raise the TPA on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA cannot be removed from the connector while there are terminals present in the connector body. View of the TPA when removed from the connector body. 4. Use the J 38125-12A tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the left side of the terminal release cavity as shown in the graphic. Use the tool to move the terminal release to the right with a gentle prying motion. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 946 Air Bag Control Module: Service and Repair Inflatable Restraint Sensing and Diagnostic Module Replacement Removal Procedure Caution: Do not strike or jolt the inflatable restraint sensing and diagnostic module (SDM). Before applying power to the SDM, make sure that it is securely fastened with the arrow facing toward the front of the vehicle. Failure to observe the correct installation procedure could cause SIR deployment, personal injury, or unnecessary SIR system repairs. Caution: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. 1. Disable the supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system. Refer to SIR Disabling and Enabling. See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming/Service and Repair 2. Remove the floor console. 3. Partially remove the console mounting bracket in order to allow access to the rear carpet. Refer to Floor Console Bracket Replacement. 4. Position the rear carpet in order to access the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM). 5. Disconnect the electrical connectors (2) from the SDM (1). 6. Remove the nuts that retain the SDM to the floor panel. 7. Remove the SDM from the vehicle. Installation Procedure 1. Remove any dirt, grease, etc. from the mounting surface. 2. Install the SDM horizontally to the vehicle. 3. Point the arrow on the SDM towards the front of the vehicle. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 4. Install the nuts that retain the SDM to the floor panel. Tighten the nuts to 12 N.m (106 lb in). Page 8081 Engine Control Module (ECM) C2 (Pin 1 To 10) Body Control Module (BCM) C1 Body Control Module (BCM) C1 Diagram Information and Instructions Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions Electrical Symbols Page 1332 5. Insert the J 38125-557 (GM P/N 12122378) into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 6. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Connector Position Assurance Locks CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of the connector. CPAs are used in various connectors throughout the vehicle. CPAs are also used in all SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals, of the connector. Connector Repairs CONNECTOR REPAIRS Page 5385 normal, replace the ECM. 6. Connect a test lamp between the relay coil B+ and the relay coil control circuit. 7. Ignition ON, command the powertrain relay ON and OFF with a scan tool. The test lamp should turn ON and OFF when changing between the commanded states. ‹› If the test lamp is always ON, test the relay coil control circuit for a short to ground. If the circuit tests normal, replace the ECM. ‹› If the test lamp is always OFF, test the relay coil control circuit for a short to voltage or an open/high resistance. If the circuit tests normal, replace the ECM. 8. Connect a 20A fused jumper wire between the relay switch B+ and the relay ignition 1 voltage circuit. 9. Ignition ON, engine OFF, monitor the EC Ignition Relay Feedback parameter with a scan tool. The parameter should display B+. ‹› If the parameter does not display B+, test the ignition 1 voltage circuit for an open/high resistance. If the circuit tests normal, replace the ECM. 10. If all circuits test normal, test or replace the relay. Component Testing 1. Ignition OFF, disconnect the powertrain relay. 2. Test for 65-110 ohms of resistance between terminals 85 and 86 of the relay. ‹› If the resistance is not within the specified range, replace the relay. 3. Test for infinite resistance between following terminals: * Terminal 30 and 86 * Terminal 30 and 87 * Terminal 30 and 85 * Terminal 85 and 87 ‹› If not the specified value, replace the relay. 4. Install a 20A fused jumper wire between relay terminal 85 and 12 volts. Install a jumper wire between relay terminal 86 and ground. Test for less than 1 ohm of resistance between terminals 30 and 87. ‹› If greater than the specified range, replace the relay. Repair Instructions Perform the Diagnostic Repair Verification after completing the diagnostic procedure. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests and Procedures * Relay Replacement (Attached to Wire Harness) Relay Replacement (Within an Electrical Center) * Underhood Electrical Center or Junction Block Replacement * Control Module References for ECM replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Page 712 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert terminal into the appropriate terminal holder until it hits bottom and stops. The correct terminal holder is determined by the wire size. Also ensure that the terminals wings are pointing towards the former on the tool and the release locator. 5. Insert the stripped cable into the terminal. Insulation should be visible on both sides of the terminal insulation wings. 6. Compress the handles until the ratchet automatically releases. 7. Place the terminal into the appropriate cavity and assemble the connector. Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO-PACK 100W) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W connectors. These connectors are very similar but use different terminals and have some minor physical differences also. Page 3419 2. Use a small flat-bladed tool to release the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting the tool in the small recess on the side of the connector and pushing up until the TPA releases from the connector body. The TPA should raise just slightly. Do not try to remove the TPA. IMPORTANT: The TPA on this connector cannot be removed unless the terminals are removed first. The TPA will come out of the connector body, but only slightly. When the TPA is slightly raised the terminals can be removed. Using excessive force to remove the TPA with the terminals still in the connector will damage the connector. 3. Repeat the process for the other side of the connector. 4. Ensure that the TPA is in the proper position to remove the terminals. Specifications Ignition Cable: Specifications Spark Plug Wire Resistance................................................................................................................. ...........................................................397-1,337 ohms Page 4285 1. Install the MAF/IAT sensor (3) to the air filter element (6). 2. Install the air filter element (6) and MAF/IAT sensor (3) to the lower air cleaner housing/washer solvent tank assembly (4). Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. Important: Ensure the air inlet duct (5) is properly positioned in the lower air cleaner housing/washer solvent tank assembly (4) before installing the air cleaner cover (2). 3. Install the air cleaner cover (2) and secure with 4 retaining screws (1). Tighten the screws to 4 N.m (35 lb in). 4. Install the radiator support diagonal brace. 5. Connect the MAF/IAT sensor electrical connector (1). 6. Install the air cleaner outlet duct. Page 5945 It is very important to use the correct test adapter when testing for proper terminal contact of fuses and relays in a bussed electrical center (BEC). Use J-35616-35 to test for proper terminal contact. Failure to use J-35616-35 can result in improper diagnosis of the BEC. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Separate the connector halves. 2. Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body. 3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J-38125 , test that the retention force is significantly different between a good terminal and a suspect terminal. Replace the female terminal in question. FLAT WIRE (DOCK AND LOCK) CONNECTORS There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock) connectors on the harness side or the component side. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Remove the component in question. 2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side of the connector as oil from your skin may be a source of contamination as well. 3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other imperfections that could cause poor terminal contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are uniform and free of damage or deformation. 4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the on the flat wire harness connector in order to test the circuit in question. CONTROL MODULE/COMPONENT VOLTAGE AND GROUNDS Poor voltage or ground connections can cause widely varying symptoms. Test all control module voltage supply circuits. Many vehicles have multiple circuits supplying voltage to a control module. Other components in the system may have separate voltage supply circuits that may also need to be tested. Inspect connections at the module/component connectors, fuses, and any intermediate connections between the voltage source and the module/component. A test lamp or a DMM may indicate that voltage is present, but neither tests the ability of the circuit to carry sufficient current. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Power Distribution Schematics. - Test all control module ground and system ground circuits. The control module may have multiple ground circuits. Other components in the system may have separate grounds that may also need to be tested. Inspect grounds for clean and tight connections at the grounding point. Inspect the connections at the component and in splice packs, where applicable. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Ground Distribution Schematics. TEMPERATURE SENSITIVITY - An intermittent condition may occur when a component/connection reaches normal operating temperature. The condition may occur only when the component/connection is cold, or only when the component/connection is hot. - Freeze Frame, Failure Records, Snapshot, or Vehicle Data Recorder data may help with this type of intermittent condition, where applicable. - If the intermittent is related to heat, review the data for a relationship with the following: High ambient temperatures - Underhood/engine generated heat - Circuit generated heat due to a poor connection, or high electrical load - Higher than normal load conditions, towing, etc. - If the intermittent is related to cold, review the data for the following: Low ambient temperatures-In extremely low temperatures, ice may form in a connection or component. Inspect for water intrusion. - The condition only occurs on a cold start. - The condition goes away when the vehicle warms up. - Information from the customer may help to determine if the trouble follows a pattern that is temperature related. - If temperature is suspected of causing an intermittent fault condition, attempt to duplicate the condition. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required. ELECTROMAGNETIC INTERFERENCE (EMI) AND ELECTRICAL NOISE Some electrical components/circuits are sensitive to electromagnetic interference (EMI) or other types of electrical noise. Inspect for the following conditions: A misrouted harness that is too close to high voltage/high current devices such as secondary ignition components, motors, generator etc-These components may induce electrical noise on a circuit that could interfere with normal circuit operation. - Electrical system interference caused by a malfunctioning relay, or a control module driven solenoid or switch-These conditions can cause a sharp electrical surge. Normally, the condition will occur when the malfunctioning component is operating. - Improper installation of non-factory or aftermarket add on accessories such as lights, 2-way radios, amplifiers, electric motors, remote starters, alarm systems, cell phones, etc-These accessories may lead to interference while in use, but do not fail when the accessories are not in use. - Test for an open diode across the A/C compressor clutch and for other open diodes. Some relays may contain a clamping diode. - The generator may be allowing AC noise into the electrical system. INCORRECT CONTROL MODULE - There are only a few situations where reprogramming a control module is appropriate: A new service control module is installed. Page 2345 The first connector design of the Micro-Pack 100W (1) has a white connector interface that holds the terminals. The second design of the Micro-Pack 100W (2) has a gray interface to hold the terminals. Also, the first design has terminal cavities that are further apart (3 mm centerline) and offset from the other row of terminal cavities in the connector. The second design has terminals cavities that are closer together (2.54 mm centerline) and aligned vertically. One other way to identify the second design is the thin strip of material that runs along the outside of the cavities. IMPORTANT: There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W terminals which are very similar. Ensure that you have the correct terminal before crimping the new terminal to the wire. The first design connector uses the longer terminal (1) that has a raised area in front of the recess in the terminal. The second design connector uses the shorter terminal without the raised area. Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro-Pack 100W connectors. Some Micro-Pack 100W connector disassembly procedures will vary. Use this procedure as a guide. 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 2573 difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Bosch Connectors (ECM) BOSCH CONNECTORS (ECM) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the assist lever on the top of the connector. Move the assist lever to the forward position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 3424 6. Gently pry the plastic terminal retainer down and carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (16-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, pull the two connector halves apart. Page 8531 11. Insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) into the 2 triangular cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 12. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE 1. Prior to installation the terminal must be aligned so the (1) coding lugs align with the (2) coding grooves on the connector. 2. Once the terminal is aligned, slide the terminal into the cavity until the retainer has engaged in the cavity of the connector. 3. Slide the TPA in the connector body and seat it using a small flat bladed tool. The TPA is seated when it is flush with the contact housing. 4. Secure the wires to the connector body using a tie wrap and replace the dress cover and grommet. Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) BOSCH CONNECTORS (2.8 JPT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Pull out the slider on the connector position assurance (CPA) until it is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 6021 If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs SIR/SRS WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS, and the wiring components, such as connectors and terminals. IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system terminals. Use either an SIR/SRS pigtail or a terminated lead from the SIR Repair Kit Tray. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves, in order to repair the SIR/SRS wiring - A special crimping tool - A heat torch - An instruction manual The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides the necessary low resistance contact integrity for these sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors SIR/SRS CONNECTOR REPAIR (PLASTIC BODY AND TERMINAL METAL PIN) The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made with a special plating. This plating provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. Use the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit for repairing SIR/SRS terminals and connectors. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the repair kit. The J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit contains: Various terminated leads for sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) terminal replacement - Various connector positive assurance (CPA) locks for SIR/SRS connectors - Base of steering column pigtail connectors part number 12085514 - Yellow vinyl electrical tape Pigtail repair packs are available for SIR/SRS connectors with eight or less terminals. Only the connector body is available for connectors with more than eight terminals. The terminated leads in the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit can be used to replace damaged terminals when replacing the connector body. SIR/SRS COMPONENT WIRE PIGTAIL REPAIR IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails. A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device, not by a connector. If a wiring pigtail is damaged, you must replace the entire component, with pigtail. The inflatable restraint steering wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component. SIR/SRS WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 787 8. If replacement of the ECM/TCM bracket is required, remove the TCM. 9. Remove the ECM/TCM bracket retaining bolts (2). 10 Remove the ECM/TCM bracket (1) from the vehicle frame. Installation Procedure 1. If the ECM/TCM bracket (1) was previously removed, install the ECM/TCM bracket (1) to the vehicle frame. 2. Install the ECM/TCM bracket retaining bolts (2). Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 3. Tighten the ECM/TCM bracket bolts. Tighten the bolts to 10 N.m (89 lb in). 4. Install the TCM. Page 8678 View of a typical Micro 64 connector. Depress the lock and pull the lever over and past the lock. Page 5588 2. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 759 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Start in the middle and gradually move the heat barrel to the open ends of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Heated Oxygen Sensor Wiring Repairs HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being obstructed. If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. - Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks, etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire. - Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance. - To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector. Page 4427 9. The illustration shows a cutaway view of the connector to aid the technician in releasing the terminal retainer. 10. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Terminal Position Assurance Locks TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Tyco/Amp Connectors (CM 42-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (CM 42-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the connector body and pull the CPA out. The CPA is on the wire harness side of connector. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Engine - MIL ON P0116/P1400 Set In Very Cold Temps Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - MIL ON P0116/P1400 Set In Very Cold Temps TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 10-06-04-008A Date: January 24, 2011 Subject: Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) Illuminated at Very Cold Ambient Temperatures When Using Engine Coolant Heater, DTC P0116 and/or P1400 Set (Relocate Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor and Engine Coolant Heater Cord) Models: 2006-2007 Buick Rainier 2009 Buick LaCrosse Super, Allure Super (Canada Only) 2006-2010 Cadillac Escalade 2006-2007 Chevrolet Monte Carlo 2006-2009 Chevrolet Impala SS, TrailBlazer 2006-2010 Chevrolet Avalanche, Express, Silverado Tahoe 2006-2009 GMC Envoy 2006-2010 GMC Savana, Sierra, Yukon 2006-2008 Pontiac Grand Prix 2006-2009 Saab 9-7X Equipped with V8 Engine RPO LC9, LH6, LH8, LH9, L76, LS2, LS4, LFA, LZ1, L92, L94, L9H or L20, L96, LMF, LMG, LY2, LY5, LY6 Please Refer to GMVIS Attention: To properly correct this condition, you must follow both of the procedures to relocate the ECT sensor and the engine coolant heater cord. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add cast iron block engine RPOs and to update the Warranty Information coverage period. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 10-06-04-008 (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). Condition Some customers may comment that the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) illuminates after starting the vehicle when they were using the engine coolant heater in very cold ambient temperatures. This usually occurs in a range of -23 to -40°C (-10 to -40°F) or colder. The technician may observe on a scan tool DTC P0116 and/or P1400 set as Current or in History. Cause This condition may be caused by the engine control module (ECM) determining that the ignition OFF time requirement has been met at start-up and interpreting the temperature difference between the engine coolant temperature (ECT) sensor and the intake air temperature (IAT) sensor as being outside of a calibrated range. Correction Important DO NOT replace the ECM for this condition. Relocating the ECT Sensor 1. Turn ON the ignition with the engine OFF. 2. Perform the diagnostic system check - vehicle. Refer to Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle in SI. ‹› If DTC P0116 and/or P1400 are set and the customer WAS using the engine coolant heater, proceed to Step 3. ‹› If DTC P0116 and/or P1400 are set and the customer WAS NOT using the engine coolant heater, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle in SI. 3. Turn OFF the ignition. Warning To avoid being burned, do not remove the radiator cap or surge tank cap while the engine is hot. The cooling system will release scalding fluid and steam Page 2150 3. Use a small flat-bladed tool to gently pry off the dress cover by inserting the tool under the cover opposite the harness side and prying up. 4. Remove the cover. 5. Using a small flat-bladed tool, push on the side of the nose piece retainer while pushing the nose piece forward with your thumb. This will release the terminal position assurance (TPA). 6. Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) into the corresponding terminal release cavity. The release cavities are the 2 center rows of cavities on one half of the connector. Page 1846 It is very important to use the correct test adapter when testing for proper terminal contact of fuses and relays in a bussed electrical center (BEC). Use J-35616-35 to test for proper terminal contact. Failure to use J-35616-35 can result in improper diagnosis of the BEC. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Separate the connector halves. 2. Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body. 3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J-38125 , test that the retention force is significantly different between a good terminal and a suspect terminal. Replace the female terminal in question. FLAT WIRE (DOCK AND LOCK) CONNECTORS There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock) connectors on the harness side or the component side. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Remove the component in question. 2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side of the connector as oil from your skin may be a source of contamination as well. 3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other imperfections that could cause poor terminal contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are uniform and free of damage or deformation. 4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the on the flat wire harness connector in order to test the circuit in question. CONTROL MODULE/COMPONENT VOLTAGE AND GROUNDS Poor voltage or ground connections can cause widely varying symptoms. Test all control module voltage supply circuits. Many vehicles have multiple circuits supplying voltage to a control module. Other components in the system may have separate voltage supply circuits that may also need to be tested. Inspect connections at the module/component connectors, fuses, and any intermediate connections between the voltage source and the module/component. A test lamp or a DMM may indicate that voltage is present, but neither tests the ability of the circuit to carry sufficient current. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Power Distribution Schematics. - Test all control module ground and system ground circuits. The control module may have multiple ground circuits. Other components in the system may have separate grounds that may also need to be tested. Inspect grounds for clean and tight connections at the grounding point. Inspect the connections at the component and in splice packs, where applicable. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Ground Distribution Schematics. TEMPERATURE SENSITIVITY - An intermittent condition may occur when a component/connection reaches normal operating temperature. The condition may occur only when the component/connection is cold, or only when the component/connection is hot. - Freeze Frame, Failure Records, Snapshot, or Vehicle Data Recorder data may help with this type of intermittent condition, where applicable. - If the intermittent is related to heat, review the data for a relationship with the following: High ambient temperatures - Underhood/engine generated heat - Circuit generated heat due to a poor connection, or high electrical load - Higher than normal load conditions, towing, etc. - If the intermittent is related to cold, review the data for the following: Low ambient temperatures-In extremely low temperatures, ice may form in a connection or component. Inspect for water intrusion. - The condition only occurs on a cold start. - The condition goes away when the vehicle warms up. - Information from the customer may help to determine if the trouble follows a pattern that is temperature related. - If temperature is suspected of causing an intermittent fault condition, attempt to duplicate the condition. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required. ELECTROMAGNETIC INTERFERENCE (EMI) AND ELECTRICAL NOISE Some electrical components/circuits are sensitive to electromagnetic interference (EMI) or other types of electrical noise. Inspect for the following conditions: A misrouted harness that is too close to high voltage/high current devices such as secondary ignition components, motors, generator etc-These components may induce electrical noise on a circuit that could interfere with normal circuit operation. - Electrical system interference caused by a malfunctioning relay, or a control module driven solenoid or switch-These conditions can cause a sharp electrical surge. Normally, the condition will occur when the malfunctioning component is operating. - Improper installation of non-factory or aftermarket add on accessories such as lights, 2-way radios, amplifiers, electric motors, remote starters, alarm systems, cell phones, etc-These accessories may lead to interference while in use, but do not fail when the accessories are not in use. - Test for an open diode across the A/C compressor clutch and for other open diodes. Some relays may contain a clamping diode. - The generator may be allowing AC noise into the electrical system. INCORRECT CONTROL MODULE - There are only a few situations where reprogramming a control module is appropriate: A new service control module is installed. Body Control Module (BCM) C1 Body Control Module (BCM) C1 Page 380 - In some cases Delphi will actually be printed on the connector. If Delphi is not printed on the connector, look for PED. In both cases there is no specific orientation for Delphi or PED and they can appear anywhere on the connector. - FCI connectors may have the FCI logo on their connectors. The logo is the letters FCI with an "A" above it. - JAE connector have JAE in small letters on their connectors. Locations Camshaft Position Sensor: Locations Engine Controls Component Views Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor 1 - Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor 2 - C110 Page 8493 7. Connect the MAF/IAT electrical connector. Page 8259 - Kostel - Molex - Sumitomo - Tyco/AMP - Yazaki Identifying the manufacturer of a connector is often difficult. When trying to determine the manufacturer of a connector, look for specific identifying marks that are unique to that connector supplier. Most of these identify marks are hard to find or see. Check the connector carefully and refer to the information below for pictures and descriptions of connector identification markings. - Most of AFLs connectors have EPC on their connector body. Some of the smaller connectors will not have any markings on them. - In some cases Bosch will actually be printed on the connector. If Bosch does not appear on the connector, look for the Bosch logo. The Bosch logo is a circle with a blunted arrow inside. This logo can appear anywhere on the connector and is often very small. Page 6598 2. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully push the terminal position assurance (TPA) towards the face of the connector on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA is fragile and may break if not done carefully. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. 3. Use the J 38125-215 tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 6086 Connector Anatomy Connector Repairs contains a list of all connector repairs. The connector repairs are listed by the connector manufacturer and then by connector type. If the technician cannot identify the manufacturer of the connector, refer to Identifying Connectors below. Knowing the connector manufacturer will assist in finding the correct connector repair from the following list: - Connector Position Assurance Locks - Terminal Position Assurance Locks - Bosch Connectors (0.64) Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) Bosch Connectors (BSK) Bosch Connectors (ECM) - Delphi Connectors (Micro.64) Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) Delphi Connectors (12-Way) - Tyco/AMP Connectors (CM 42-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) Tyco/AMP Connectors (025 Cap) Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) - Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) - Repairing Connector Terminals IDENTIFYING CONNECTORS Knowing the connector manufacturer is helpful when trying to locating the correct connector repair procedure. There are many different connector designs used on GM vehicles and it is sometimes difficult to identify the connector manufacturer. The information in this document should help with the identification of connector manufactures. The following connector manufacturers make most of the connectors found in GM vehicles: AFL/EPC (Alcoa Fujikura Ltd./Engineered Plastics Components) - Bosch - Delphi - FCI (Framatome Connectors International) - JAE (Japan Aviation Electronics) - JST (Japan Solderless Terminals) Page 837 5. Insert the J 38125-557 (GM P/N 12122378) into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 6. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Connector Position Assurance Locks CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of the connector. CPAs are used in various connectors throughout the vehicle. CPAs are also used in all SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals, of the connector. Connector Repairs CONNECTOR REPAIRS Page 2166 If a wire is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm, etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except coaxial. - Do not use the DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent American wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 5391 Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Diagrams Engine Controls Connector End Views Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor Page 212 7. Apply pressure and gently rock the cover until one locking leg is unseated. 8. Continue to apply pressure and rock the cover until the second locking leg is unseated. Repeat procedure for the other side of the dress cover and remove the cover. 9. Use J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) to gently lift the terminal retaining tab while gently pulling the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 10. If the terminal is severely bent or damaged, it may be possible on some connectors to push the wire out of the front of the connector instead of Page 8881 Page 3359 - A control module from another vehicle is installed. - Revised software/calibration files have been released for this vehicle. - IMPORTANT: DO NOT re-program the control module with the SAME software/calibration files that are already present in the control module. This is not an effective repair for any type of concern. Verify that the control module contains the correct software/calibration. If incorrect programming is found, reprogram the control module with the most current software/calibration. Refer to Control Module References for replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Testing for Short to Ground TESTING FOR SHORT TO GROUND NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 4. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit. With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is a short to ground in the circuit. Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2. Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). - When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. - If the DMM does not display voltage 4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is shorted. Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A DIGITAL MULTIMETER NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the powertrain control module (PCM), should only be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200 Digital Multimeter (DMM). The J 39200 instruction manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminage even though voltage is present. The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity. IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading. Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the measurement. Page 7171 5. Insert the J 38125-557 (GM P/N 12122378) into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 6. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Connector Position Assurance Locks CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of the connector. CPAs are used in various connectors throughout the vehicle. CPAs are also used in all SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals, of the connector. Connector Repairs CONNECTOR REPAIRS Service and Repair Front Crankshaft Seal: Service and Repair Crankshaft Front Oil Seal Replacement Tools Required J 41478 Crankshaft Front Oil Seal Installer Removal Procedure 1. Remove the radiator. Refer to Radiator Replacement (LH6, Ls2) Radiator Replacement (LL8). 2. Remove the crankshaft balancer. Refer to Crankshaft Balancer Replacement. 3. Remove the crankshaft oil seal (1) from the front cover. Installation Procedure Important: ^ Do not lubricate the oil seal sealing surface. ^ Do not reuse the crankshaft oil seal. 1. Lubricate the outer edge of the oil seal (1) with clean engine oil. 2. Lubricate the front cover oil seal bore with clean engine oil. 3. Install the crankshaft front oil seal onto the J 41478 guide. 4. Install J 41478 threaded rod with nut, washer, guide, and oil seal into the end of the crankshaft. Page 3995 Drive Belt: Testing and Inspection Drive Belt Falls Off and Excessive Wear Diagnosis Drive Belt Falls Off and Excessive Wear Diagnosis Diagnostic Aids If the drive belt repeatedly falls off the drive belt pulleys, this is because of pulley misalignment. An extra load that is quickly applied on released by an accessory drive component may cause the drive belt to fall off the pulleys. Verify the accessory drive components operate properly. If the drive belt is the incorrect length, the drive belt tensioner may not keep the proper tension on the drive belt. Excessive wear on a drive belt is usually caused by an incorrect installation or the wrong drive belt for the application. Minor misalignment of the drive belt pulleys will not cause excessive wear, but will probably cause the drive belt to make a noise or to fall off. Excessive misalignment of the drive belt pulleys will cause excessive wear but may also make the drive belt fall off. Test Description The numbers below refer to the step numbers on the diagnostic table. 2. This inspection is to verify the condition of the drive belt. Damage may have occurred to the drive belt when the drive belt fell off. The drive belt may of been damaged, which caused the drive belt to fall off. Inspect the belt for cuts, tears, sections of ribs missing, or damaged belt plys. 4. Misalignment of the pulleys may be caused from improper mounting of the accessory drive component, incorrect installation of the accessory drive component pulley, or the pulley bent inward or outward from a previous repair. Test for a misaligned pulley using a straight edge in the pulley grooves across 2 or 3 pulleys. If a misaligned pulley is found refer to that accessory drive component for the proper installation procedure of that pulley. 5. Inspecting the pulleys for being bent should include inspecting for a dent or other damage to the pulleys that would prevent the drive belt from not seating properly in all of the pulley grooves or on the smooth surface of a pulley when the back side of the belt is used to drive the pulley. 6. Accessory drive component brackets that are bent or cracked will let the drive belt fall off. 7. Inspecting of the fasteners can eliminate the possibility that a wrong bolt, nut, spacer, or washer was installed. Missing. loose, or the wrong fasteners may cause pulley misalignment from the bracket moving under load. Over tightening of the fasteners may cause misalignment of the accessory component bracket. 13. The inspection is to verify the drive belt is correctly installed on all of the drive belt pulleys. Wear on the drive belt may be caused by mis-positioning the drive belt by one groove on a pulley. 14. The installation of a drive belt that is too wide or too narrow will cause wear on the drive belt. The drive belt ribs should match all of the grooves on all of the pulleys. 15. This inspection is to verify the drive belt is not contacting any parts of the engine or body while the engine is operating. There should be sufficient clearance when the drive belt accessory drive components load varies. The drive belt should not come in contact with an engine or a body component when snapping the throttle. Testing and Inspection Wheel Bearing: Testing and Inspection Wheel Bearings Diagnosis Step 1 - Step 7 Page 6306 If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200 DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J 39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected. IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J 39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and maximum (MAX) values measured. 1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of a suspected circuit to the other. 2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J 39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep). IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value in order to record the full change. 5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling the connections or the wiring, test driving, or performing other operations. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions. 6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9. Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist. Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections TESTING FOR INTERMITTENT CONDITIONS AND POOR CONNECTIONS TOOLS REQUIRED - J 35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit - J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit When the condition is not currently present, but is indicated in DTC history, the cause may be intermittent. An intermittent may also be the cause when there is a customer complaint, but the symptom cannot be duplicated. Refer to the Symptom Table of the system that is suspect of causing the condition before trying to locate an intermittent condition. Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the following items: Wiring broken inside the insulation - Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector - Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself, and corrosion in the wire to terminal contact area, etc. - Pierced or damaged insulation can allow moisture to enter the wiring causing corrosion. The conductor can corrode inside the insulation, with little visible evidence. Look for swollen and stiff sections of wire in the suspect circuits. - Wiring which has been pinched, cut, or its insulation rubbed through may cause an intermittent open or short as the bare area touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle. - Wiring that comes in contact with hot or exhaust components - Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required, in order to verify the customer concern. - Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. - Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis and Vehicle Data Recorder operation. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any inline connectors before replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation. Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination, usually in the underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit. Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper adapter. Always use the J 35616 when probing connectors. Other causes of terminal deformation are improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT IN BUSSED ELECTRICAL CENTERS (BEC) Page 3743 - Yazaki has a wedge or arrow shape, similar to that shown. Delphi Connectors (Micro .64) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro 64 connectors. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. The lever lock may be located on the top or sides of the wire dress cover. Page 8372 Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids Arrows and Symbols Arrows and Symbols This Service Data uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations. Arrows and Symbols 1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow Basic Knowledge Required GENERAL ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures contained in the service manual. You should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current (amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram, as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. Decimal and Metric Equivalents Decimal and Metric Equivalents Page 6259 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert a small flat-blade tool in the slot below the front loaded terminal position assurance (TPA) and pry up. 3. Remove the TPA by pulling it out of the connector. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-553 (GM P/N 15315247) on a slight upward angle into the cavity below the terminal to be removed. Ensure that the pointed on the end of the tool is facing the bottom of the terminal and it stays in contact with the terminal until it stops on the plastic terminal retainer. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 572 4 - Console Mode Actuator - Auxiliary 5 - C309 6 - C307 Page 2020 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry one side of the nose piece up to the pre-stage position. When the nose piece is in the pre-staged position, the nose piece will be raised above the connector body the length of the step in the nose piece. 7. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry the other side of the piece to the pre-stage position. If the nose piece is higher than the first step in the nose piece, gently push down on the nose piece until it meets with resistance from the connector body, you should feel the nose piece click into position. Page 8867 US English/Metric Conversion US English/Metric Conversion Page 1487 3. Use a small flat-bladed tool to gently pry off the dress cover by inserting the tool under the cover opposite the harness side and prying up. 4. Remove the cover. 5. Using a small flat-bladed tool, push on the side of the nose piece retainer while pushing the nose piece forward with your thumb. This will release the terminal position assurance (TPA). 6. Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) into the corresponding terminal release cavity. The release cavities are the 2 center rows of cavities on one half of the connector. Page 8835 5. Once the nose piece retainers are relaxed, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should raise slightly. 6. On the opposite side of the nose piece, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should release completely. If the nose piece does not come off, repeat the procedure on the opposite side. Page 2533 For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 1927 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches, and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original. - The wires insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the possibility of fuel contact. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1). 5. Select the proper duraseal splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool. Refer to the Crimp and Seal Splice Table. 6. Place the duraseal splice sleeve in the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115) crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 7. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to hold the duraseal splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 8. Insert the wires into the duraseal splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel in order to prevent the wire from passing through the splice (3). 9. Close the handles of the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115), until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is applied to the splice sleeve. 10. Shrink the insulation around the splice. - Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. - Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Splicing Inline Harness Diodes SPLICING INLINE HARNESS DIODES Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure. 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode. 2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool. 5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode. Page 8427 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the rear TPA from the connector. 7. IMPORTANT: The front TPA cannot be removed from the connector. Only move it to the release point. Use a small flat-blade tool to move the front TPA to the release position. 8. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 9. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Molex Connectors Page 5851 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the rear TPA from the connector. 7. IMPORTANT: The front TPA cannot be removed from the connector. Only move it to the release point. Use a small flat-blade tool to move the front TPA to the release position. 8. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 9. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Molex Connectors Page 8605 Knock Sensor: Connector Views Engine Controls Connector End Views Knock Sensor (KS) 1 - Left Knock Sensor (KS) 2 - Right Page 7544 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert a small flat-blade tool in the slot below the front loaded terminal position assurance (TPA) and pry up. 3. Remove the TPA by pulling it out of the connector. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-553 (GM P/N 15315247) on a slight upward angle into the cavity below the terminal to be removed. Ensure that the pointed on the end of the tool is facing the bottom of the terminal and it stays in contact with the terminal until it stops on the plastic terminal retainer. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 4586 vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide variety of actions, including: - Wiggling the harness - Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting - Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector - Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation - Relocating a harness or wires All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. Another option is, with the component commanded ON and OFF by the scan tool, move related connectors and wiring and observe the component operation. With the engine running, move related connectors and wiring while monitoring engine operation. If harness or connector movement affects the data displayed, component/system operation, or engine operation, inspect and repair the harness/connections as necessary. You may need to load the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these cases you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide good results as well. There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions, along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the circuit to these kinds of conditions. SALT WATER SPRAY Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture. Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5 percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously. HIGH TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070. Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault condition. The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis. This option does not allow for the same control, however. LOW TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect. If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to -18°C (0°F) from one end and +71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized cooling needs. Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or components in an effort to duplicate the concern. DUPLICATING FAILURE CONDITIONS - If none of the previous tests are successful, attempt to duplicate and/or capture the failure conditions. Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, where applicable, contains the conditions that were present when the DTC set. 1. Review and record Freeze Frame/Failure Records data. 2. Clear the DTCs using the scan tool. 3. Turn the key to OFF and wait 15 seconds. 4. Operate the vehicle under the same conditions that were noted in Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, as closely as possible. The vehicle must also be operating within the Conditions for Running the DTC. Refer to Conditions for Running the DTC in the supporting text if a DTC is being diagnosed. 5. Monitor DTC Status for the DTC being tested. The scan tool will indicate Ran, when the enabling conditions have been satisfied long enough for the DTC to run. The scan tool will also indicate whether the DTC passed or failed. - An alternate method is to drive the vehicle with the DMM connected to a suspected circuit. An abnormal reading on the DMM when the concern occurs, may help you locate the concern. Measuring Frequency Page 8535 - In some cases Delphi will actually be printed on the connector. If Delphi is not printed on the connector, look for PED. In both cases there is no specific orientation for Delphi or PED and they can appear anywhere on the connector. - FCI connectors may have the FCI logo on their connectors. The logo is the letters FCI with an "A" above it. - JAE connector have JAE in small letters on their connectors. Page 5001 under pressure if the radiator cap or the surge tank cap is removed while the engine and radiator are still hot. 4. Remove the surge tank fill cap from the surge tank or the coolant pressure cap from the radiator. 5. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle in SI. 6. Place a clean drain pan under the radiator drain cock or under the lower radiator hose depending on the vehicle. Refer to Cooling System Draining and Filling in SI. 7. Loosen the radiator drain cock if equipped or use J 38185 clamp pliers and reposition the clamp on the lower radiator hose at the radiator. 8. Remove the end of the lower radiator hose from the radiator. 9. Drain the engine coolant sufficiently below the level of the ECT sensor. 10. Close the radiator drain cock or connect the lower radiator hose at the radiator. 11. Use the J 38185 clamp pliers to place the clamp into the original position on the hose. 12. Lower the vehicle. 13. Disconnect the wiring harness connector from the ECT sensor (2). 14. Remove the ECT sensor (1) from the front of the cylinder head. 15. Remove the corresponding size plug at the rear of the OTHER cylinder head. 16. Coat the threads of the ECT sensor with sealer. Use GM P/N 12346004 (Canadian P/N 10953480) or an equivalent. 17. Install the ECT sensor in the hole of the cylinder head where the plug was removed. Tighten Tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb ft). 18. Coat the threads of the plug with sealer. Use GM P/N 12346004 (Canadian P/N 10953480) or an equivalent. 19. Install the plug in the hole of the cylinder head where the ECT sensor was removed Tighten Tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb ft). Important Leave enough wire attached to the ECT sensor harness connector in order to create manageable splices that are at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splice. Page 7833 11. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 12. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 13. Center the high temperature SCT1 shrink tube over the DuraSeal splice sleeve. 14. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the high temperature heat shrink tubing. 15. Gradually move the heat from the center to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 16. Replace any reflective tape and clips that may have been remove during the repair. Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation REPAIRING DAMAGED WIRE INSULATION Wire Size Conversion Page 7428 Engine Control Module (ECM) C3 (Pin 16 To 59) Page 1838 Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Page 5555 4. Once the front 2 locks are unlocked, lift the front of the dress cover and pull it forward. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the small slot on the TPA and pushing down until the TPA releases. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to angle or rock the J 38125-21 tool when inserting it into the connector or the tool may break. Insert the J 38125-21 (GM P/N 15381651-2) tool into the round canal between the terminals cavities at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to repair Micro 64 connector terminals. The Micro 64 connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-64 (M jaw) was developed to crimp Micro 64 terminals. The J 38125-64 crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. The J 38125-64 crimping tool is also designed to crimp both the wire and the insulation at the same time. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro 64 terminals. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. 1. Cut the wire as close to the damaged terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. Page 1814 For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 3923 Engine Block Heater: Service and Repair Coolant Heater Replacement (LL8) Coolant Heater Replacement (LL8) Removal Procedure 1. Drain the engine coolant. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System (LL8) Draining and Filling Cooling System (LH6, LS2). 2. Remove the powertrain control module (PCM) retaining bolts (3) and nuts (6). 3. Remove the PCM mounting studs (5) and position the PCM out of the way. 4. Disconnect the engine coolant temperature (ECT) sensor electrical connector (1). Notice: Refer to Fuel and Evaporative Emission Hose/Pipe Connection Cleaning Notice. Page 1652 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches, and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original. - The wires insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the possibility of fuel contact. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1). 5. Select the proper duraseal splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool. Refer to the Crimp and Seal Splice Table. 6. Place the duraseal splice sleeve in the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115) crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 7. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to hold the duraseal splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 8. Insert the wires into the duraseal splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel in order to prevent the wire from passing through the splice (3). 9. Close the handles of the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115), until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is applied to the splice sleeve. 10. Shrink the insulation around the splice. - Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. - Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Splicing Inline Harness Diodes SPLICING INLINE HARNESS DIODES Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure. 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode. 2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool. 5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode. Page 1445 11. Insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) into the 2 triangular cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 12. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE 1. Prior to installation the terminal must be aligned so the (1) coding lugs align with the (2) coding grooves on the connector. 2. Once the terminal is aligned, slide the terminal into the cavity until the retainer has engaged in the cavity of the connector. 3. Slide the TPA in the connector body and seat it using a small flat bladed tool. The TPA is seated when it is flush with the contact housing. 4. Secure the wires to the connector body using a tie wrap and replace the dress cover and grommet. Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) BOSCH CONNECTORS (2.8 JPT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Pull out the slider on the connector position assurance (CPA) until it is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 2129 Release the lower wiredress cover locking tab. Release the upper wiredress cover locking tab. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. Page 3378 - Yazaki has a wedge or arrow shape, similar to that shown. Delphi Connectors (Micro .64) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro 64 connectors. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. The lever lock may be located on the top or sides of the wire dress cover. Page 4180 7. Install the vacuum brake booster hose to the rear of the intake manifold. 8. Connect the fuel feed pipe (3) to the fuel rail (2). Refer to Metal Collar Quick Connect Fitting Service. Page 2206 to analyze the data during the time a vehicle condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a trigger point that you have determined. Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2 snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a first-in, first-out basis. If a third snapshot is taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost. Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types: Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice - Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200 frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not lost if the Scan Tool is powered down. The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis. The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected values by plotting 3 parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful, especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC. Testing for a Short to Voltage TESTING FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4. Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt, there is a short to voltage in the circuit. Testing for Continuity TESTING FOR CONTINUITY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6. Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit. 7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity. With a Test Lamp IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits. 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6. If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity. Testing for Electrical Intermittents TESTING FOR ELECTRICAL INTERMITTENTS Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment. - Testing for Short to Ground - Testing for Continuity - Testing for a Short to Voltage Page 3761 4. Use a small flat-blade tool to slide the terminal position assurance (TPA) up one notch on both ends of the connector. The TPA is located underneath the wire dress cover. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 8290 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. 4. Remove the dress cover by using a flat bladed tool to release the dress cover locking tabs and lift up on the dress cover. 5. Cut the tie wrap that holds the wires to the connector body. Page 1834 Utility/Van Zoning UTILITY/VAN ZONING Radiator Inlet Hose Replacement Radiator Hose: Service and Repair Radiator Inlet Hose Replacement Radiator Inlet Hose Replacement (LH6, LS2) Tools Required J 38185 Hose Clamp Pliers Removal Procedure 1. Drain the cooling system. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System (LL8) Draining and Filling Cooling System (LH6, LS2). 2. Remove the air intake resonator. Refer to Air Cleaner Resonator Outlet Duct Replacement for the 5.3L engine or Air Cleaner Resonator Outlet Duct Replacement for the 6.0L engine. 3. Using J 38185 reposition the radiator inlet hose clamp (1) from the engine. 4. Remove the outlet hose from the engine. 5. Using J 38185 reposition the radiator inlet hose clamp (2) from the radiator. 6. Remove the radiator outlet hose from the radiator. Installation Procedure Page 2198 Throttle Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids Arrows and Symbols Arrows and Symbols This Service Data uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations. Arrows and Symbols 1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow Basic Knowledge Required GENERAL ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures contained in the service manual. You should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current (amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram, as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. Decimal and Metric Equivalents Decimal and Metric Equivalents Page 9077 View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. View of the release tool being used for the smaller terminals. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (2-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 702 Connector Anatomy Connector Repairs contains a list of all connector repairs. The connector repairs are listed by the connector manufacturer and then by connector type. If the technician cannot identify the manufacturer of the connector, refer to Identifying Connectors below. Knowing the connector manufacturer will assist in finding the correct connector repair from the following list: - Connector Position Assurance Locks - Terminal Position Assurance Locks - Bosch Connectors (0.64) Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) Bosch Connectors (BSK) Bosch Connectors (ECM) - Delphi Connectors (Micro.64) Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) Delphi Connectors (12-Way) - Tyco/AMP Connectors (CM 42-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) Tyco/AMP Connectors (025 Cap) Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) - Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) - Repairing Connector Terminals IDENTIFYING CONNECTORS Knowing the connector manufacturer is helpful when trying to locating the correct connector repair procedure. There are many different connector designs used on GM vehicles and it is sometimes difficult to identify the connector manufacturer. The information in this document should help with the identification of connector manufactures. The following connector manufacturers make most of the connectors found in GM vehicles: AFL/EPC (Alcoa Fujikura Ltd./Engineered Plastics Components) - Bosch - Delphi - FCI (Framatome Connectors International) - JAE (Japan Aviation Electronics) - JST (Japan Solderless Terminals) Page 9063 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 6123 5. Once the nose piece retainers are relaxed, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should raise slightly. 6. On the opposite side of the nose piece, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should release completely. If the nose piece does not come off, repeat the procedure on the opposite side. Locations Heated Glass Element Relay: Locations Fuse Block - Rear, Label Page 8208 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link). - The wire insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. 5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold them between thumb and forefinger. 7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place. - Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction. - Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip. 8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool closes.Ensure that no strands of wire are cut. 10. Crimp the splice on each end (2). ABS/TCS - StabiliTrak(R) Indicator Blinking/DTC C0196 Electronic Brake Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins ABS/TCS - StabiliTrak(R) Indicator Blinking/DTC C0196 TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 08-05-25-005 Date: October 01, 2008 Subject: Intermittent StabiliTrak(R) Indicator Light Blinking, StabiliTrak(R) Active Message Displayed, DTC C0196 Set (Reprogram Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM)) Models: 2006-2007 Buick Rainier 2006-2009 Chevrolet TrailBlazer Models 2006-2009 GMC Envoy Models 2006-2009 Saab 97X 2006-2009 Isuzu Ascender Models This bulletin provides information on two different conditions. Condition # 1 Some customers may comment on a Service StabiliTrak(R) indicator light along with a Service StabiliTrak(R) message displayed in the DIC. Upon investigation, the technician may find DTC C0196 set in history. Condition # 2 Some customers may comment on a blinking StabiliTrak(R) indicator light along with a StabiliTrak Active message displayed in the DIC during normal driving conditions. No DTCs will be found with this concern. Cause This condition may be caused by a software anomaly within the electronic brake control module (EBCM) that allowed the yaw offset to be falsely learned. Correction Important: From the controller list, select "VSES Vehicle Stability Enhancement System Control Module". If routine diagnosis using SI does not reveal any obvious cause, reprogram the EBCM using SPS with the latest software available on TIS2WEB. Refer to the Service Programming System (SPS) procedures in SI. As always, make sure your Tech 2(R) is updated with the latest software version. Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models) Page 8714 2. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 5408 Page 1921 11. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 12. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 13. Center the high temperature SCT1 shrink tube over the DuraSeal splice sleeve. 14. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the high temperature heat shrink tubing. 15. Gradually move the heat from the center to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 16. Replace any reflective tape and clips that may have been remove during the repair. Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation REPAIRING DAMAGED WIRE INSULATION Wire Size Conversion Page 4521 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. JST Connectors JST CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, remove the connector from the component. Page 5654 Page 6616 Page 5667 Refer to the following table as a guide in selecting the correct test adapter for front probing connectors: Backprobe IMPORTANT: Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures. - Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector. - Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large of a test probe. - After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected, test for proper terminal contact. Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the connector. Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure SCAN TOOL SNAPSHOT PROCEDURE Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used Specifications Idle Speed: Specifications Information not supplied by Manufacturer. Page 1781 Open the harness by removing any tape. 2. Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. 3. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 4. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent american wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 5. Slide a section of high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing down the length of wire to be spliced. Ensure that the shrink tubing will not interfere with the splice procedure. 6. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 7. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. 8. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 9. Insert the wire into the DuraSeal splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 10. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Page 4565 5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape. Seat Belt Schematic Icons Seat Belt Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons Tire Monitor System - TPM Sensor Information Tire Pressure Monitor Receiver / Transponder: Technical Service Bulletins Tire Monitor System TPM Sensor Information INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 08-03-16-003 Date: May 12, 2008 Subject: Warranty Reduction - Transfer of Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensors to Replacement Wheels and Allowable TPM Sensor Replacements Models: 2000-2009 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2003-2009 HUMMER H2 2006-2009 HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7x with On-Wheel TPM Sensors TPM Sensor / Wheel Warranty Reviews During the last warranty review period it was noted that wheels being returned under the GM New Vehicle Warranty were being shipped back to General Motors with the TPM sensor still attached to the wheel. Return rates ran as high as 60% with the TPM sensors still attached. Operational TPM sensors should not be returned to GM and are to be transferred to replacement wheels if they become necessary. Important: Operational TPM Sensors that are returned under warranty to General Motors will be charged back to the dealer.Sensors have a 10 year /150,000 mile (240,000 km) battery life, and should be transferred if one or more wheels are replaced. TPM Valve Stem / Grommet (0-ring) Replacement When the TPM sensors are transferred to new wheels you should replace the component used to seal the TPM sensor stem to the wheel. On sensors with an aluminum stem and visible nut on the outside of the wheel a replacement grommet (0-ring) should be used to assure a proper seal. The sensor retaining nut (except Aveo) should be tightened to 7 N.m (62 lb in) for all vehicles except Pontiac Vibe (4.0 N.m (35.4 lb in)). Important: ^ DO NOT overtorque the retaining nut. Notice: ^ Factory installed TPM Sensors come with plastic aluminum or nickel-plated brass stem caps. These caps should not be changed. Chrome plated steel caps may cause corrosion of aluminum valve stems due to incompatibility of the metals. On current style sensors the entire rubber stem is replaceable. The service interval on the revised TPM sensor with replaceable stem is the same as for any other traditional valve stem. Replace the stem at the time of tire replacement sensor transfer or whenever air seepage is suspected at the valve stem. When replacing the valve stem tighten the screw to 1.3 N.m (11.5 lb in). For either style of TPM sensor see the service parts guide for the correct GM part numbers to order and use. Disclaimer Page 6421 Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. For connectors with a bolt in the dress cover, turn the bolt counterclockwise to remove the connector from the component. 2. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. Page 148 Important The following information MUST be documented on the repair order. Failure to do so may result in a chargeback. - Customer vehicle condition. - Was a Service Lamp or Service Message illuminated? If yes, specify which Service Lamp or Service Message. - Was a DTC(s) set? If yes, specify which DTC(s) were set. - After following the procedure contained within this bulletin, could the condition be duplicated? ‹› If the condition was not duplicated, then document the affected module/component connector name and number on the repair order. - If the condition was duplicated after the procedure contained within this bulletin was followed, and additional diagnosis led to the replacement of a module or component, the SI Document ID Number MUST be written on the repair order. Parts Information Alternate Distributor For All of North America Note NyoGel(R) 760G Lubricant* is equivalent to GMSPO P/N 12377900, and P/N 10953529 (Canada), specified for use to correct the condition in this bulletin. *We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may be available from other sources. Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to: Warranty Information (Saab Models) Specifications Camshaft Gear/Sprocket: Specifications Camshaft Sprocket bolts First Pass tighten to ............................................................................................................................. ................................................... 75 N.m (55 lb ft) Final Pass tighten to ............................................. ........................................................................................................................................... 50 degrees Inspect the sprockets for proper alignment. The mark on the camshaft sprocket (1) should be located in the 6 o'clock position and the mark on the crankshaft sprocket (2) should be located in the 12 o'clock position. Page 9064 3. Remove the dress cover by using a flat-blade tool to release the connector locking tabs and pulling off the dress cover. 4. Relieve the tension on the nose piece retainers by inserting J-38125-12A (12094429) into the single retainer slot on the end of the nose piece and gently prying out the locking tab. Repeat the process for both of the nose piece locking tabs on the opposite side of the nose piece. Page 448 Page 8794 IMPORTANT: Ensure that the dress cover and connector body are both in the released position before reassembling. Failure to do so may cause damage to the connector and component. Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (0.64) BOSCH CONNECTORS (0.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While pressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock until the lever is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Pull the rubber boot that covers the wires back to expose the end of the connector dress cover. 4. Place the connector locking lever in the center of the connector. 5. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs that are on the wire end of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover and connector body and pry up. Page 1960 Utility/Van Zoning UTILITY/VAN ZONING Page 2255 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. 4. Remove the dress cover by using a flat bladed tool to release the dress cover locking tabs and lift up on the dress cover. 5. Cut the tie wrap that holds the wires to the connector body. Page 4714 Flushing Procedures using DEX-COOL(R) Important: The following procedure recommends refilling the system with DEX-COOL(R), P/N 12346290 (in Canada, use P/N 10953464), GM specification 6277M. This coolant is orange in color and has a service interval of 5 years or 240,000 km (150,000 mi). However, when used on vehicles built prior to the introduction of DEX-COOL(R), maintenance intervals will remain the same as specified in the Owner's Manual. ^ If available, use the approved cooling system flush and fill machine (available through the GM Dealer Equipment Program) following the manufacturer's operating instructions. ^ If approved cooling system flush and fill machine is not available, drain the coolant and dispose of properly following the draining procedures in the appropriate Service Manual. Refill the system using clear, drinkable water and run the vehicle until the thermostat opens. Repeat and run the vehicle three (3) times to totally remove the old coolant or until the drained coolant is almost clear. Once the system is completely flushed, refill the cooling system to a 50%-60% concentration with DEX‐COOL(R), P/N 12346290 (in Canada, use P/N 10953464), GM specification 6277M, following the refill procedures in the appropriate Service Manual. If a Service Manual is not available, fill half the capacity of the system with 100% DEX-COOL(R), P/N 12346290 (in Canada, use P/N 10953464), GM specification 6277M. Then slowly add clear, drinkable water (preferably distilled) to the system until the level of the coolant mixture has reached the base of the radiator neck. Wait two (2) minutes and reverify the coolant level. If necessary, add clean water to restore the coolant to the appropriate level. Once the system is refilled, reverify the coolant concentration using a Refractometer J 23688 (Fahrenheit scale) or J 26568 (centigrade scale) coolant tester, or equivalent. The concentration levels should be between 50% and 65%. Flushing Procedures using Conventional Silicated (Green Colored) Coolant Important: 2004-2005 Chevrolet Aveo (Pontiac Wave, Canada Only) does not use DEX‐COOL(R). The Aveo and Wave are filled with conventional, silicated engine coolant that is blue in color. Silicated coolants are typically green in color and are required to be drained, flushed and refilled every 30,000 miles (48,000 km). The Aveo and Wave are to be serviced with conventional, silicated coolant. Use P/N 12378560 (1 gal) (in Canada, use P/N 88862159 (1 L). Refer to the Owner's Manual or Service Information (SI) for further information on OEM coolant. Important: Do not mix the OEM orange colored DEX-COOL(R) coolant with green colored coolant when adding coolant to the system or when servicing the vehicle's cooling system. Mixing the orange and green colored coolants will produce a brown coolant which may be a customer dissatisfier and will not extend the service interval to that of DEX-COOL(R). Conventional silicated coolants offered by GM Service and Parts Operations are green in color. ^ If available, use the approved cooling system flush and fill machine (available through the GM Dealer Equipment Program) following the manufacturer's operating instructions. ^ If approved cooling systems flush and fill machine is not available, drain coolant and dispose of properly following the draining procedures in appropriate Service Manual. Refill the system using clear, drinkable water and run vehicle until thermostat opens. Repeat and run vehicle three (3) times to totally remove old coolant or until drained coolant is almost clear. Once the system is completely flushed, refill the cooling system to a 50%-60% concentration with a good quality ethylene glycol base engine coolant, P/N 12378560, 1 gal (in Canada, use P/N 88862159 1 L), conforming to GM specification 1825M, or recycled coolant conforming to GM specification 1825M, following the refill procedures in the appropriate Service Manual. If a Service Manual is not available, fill half the capacity of the system with 100% good quality ethylene glycol base (green colored) engine coolant, P/N 12378560 1 gal., (in Canada, use P/N 88862159 1 L) conforming to GM specification 1825M. Then slowly add clear, drinkable water (preferably distilled) to system until the level of the coolant mixture has reached the base of the radiator neck. Wait two (2) minutes and recheck coolant level. If necessary, add clean water to restore coolant to the appropriate level. Once the system is refilled, recheck the coolant concentration using a Refractometer J 23688 (Fahrenheit scale) or J 26568 (centigrade scale) coolant tester, or equivalent. Concentration levels should be between 50% and 65%. Parts Information Warranty Information Page 194 5. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove TPA from the connector. 6. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Page 3058 4. Install the power steering hose assembly (1) to the vehicle. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 5. Install the power steering hose assembly rear bracket (2) mounting bolt. Tighten the bolt to 10 N.m (89 lb in). 6. Install the power steering pressure hose retaining clip. 7. Install the power steering hose assembly front bracket mounting bolt (3). 8. Install the power steering cooler hose (3) to the power steering pump (2). Notice: Refer to Component Fastener Tightening Notice. 9. Connect the power steering pressure (1) to the power steering pump (2). Tighten the power steering pressure hose fitting to 25 N.m (18 lb in). 10. Install the ECM to the ECM mounting bracket. Refer to Engine Control Module Replacement. 11. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. Page 512 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. JST Connectors JST CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, remove the connector from the component. Page 4835 3. Remove the dress cover by using a flat-blade tool to release the connector locking tabs and pulling off the dress cover. 4. Relieve the tension on the nose piece retainers by inserting J-38125-12A (12094429) into the single retainer slot on the end of the nose piece and gently prying out the locking tab. Repeat the process for both of the nose piece locking tabs on the opposite side of the nose piece. Page 3795 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Start in the middle and gradually move the heat barrel to the open ends of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Heated Oxygen Sensor Wiring Repairs HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being obstructed. If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. - Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks, etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire. - Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance. - To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector. Page 750 Release the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the blue locking tabs on both ends of the connector. Gently slide the TPA up to the released position on both ends. 6. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-13A (GM P/N 12031876-1) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. Page 8548 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Ensure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the Terminal Removal Procedure. Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PULL TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL If the terminal is visibly damaged or is suspected of having a faulty connection, the terminal should be replaced. Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors: 1. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) device and/or the secondary lock. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component or separate the connectors for in-line connectors. 3. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device. 4. Insert the proper pick or removal tool into the front of the connector body. 5. IMPORTANT: On connectors with more than one terminal the service loop may not be large enough to remove the terminal and crimp on a new one. If the terminal wire does not have a large enough service loop for removal, cut the wire 5 cm (2 in) behind the connector before removal. Grasp the wire at the back of the connector body and gently push the terminal out the front of the connector body. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. If the wire needed to be cut in order to remove the terminal, gently push a small length of the same size wire through the back of the connector cavity until there is enough wire exposed in order to crimp on a new terminal. If the wire was not cut, cut the existing wire as close to the old terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 4. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. TERMINAL INSTALLATION 1. Align the terminal and pull the wire from the back of the connector in order to seat the terminal. 2. If necessary, cut the new wire to proper length and splice with existing circuit. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. 3. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply dielectric grease to the connector. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PUSH TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 1621 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 3888 Disclaimer Page 7252 Data Link Connector: Testing and Inspection DATA LINK REFERENCES DIAGNOSTIC AIDS The air suspension control module does not communicate on any data link. For additional information refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) Displaying. This table identifies which serial data link that a particular module uses for in-vehicle data transmission. Some modules may use more than one data link to communicate. Some modules may have multiple communication circuits passing through them without actively communicating on that data link. This table is used to assist in correcting a communication malfunction. For the description and operation of these serial data communication circuits refer to Data Link Communications Description and Operation. TEST Page 6850 Compression Check: Testing and Inspection Engine Compression Test 1. Charge the battery if the battery is not fully charged. 2. Disable the ignition system. 3. Disable the fuel injection system. 4. Remove all spark plugs. 5. Turn the ignition to the ON position. 6. Depress the accelerator pedal to position the throttle plate wide open. 7. Start with the compression gage at zero and crank the engine through 4 compression strokes, 4 puffs. 8. Measure the compression for each cylinder. Record the readings. 9. If a cylinder has low compression, inject approximately 15 ml (1 tablespoon) of engine oil into the combustion chamber through the spark plug hole. Measure the compression again and record the reading. 10. The minimum compression in any 1 cylinder should not be less than 70 percent of the highest cylinder. No cylinder should read less than 690 kPa (100 psi). For example, if the highest pressure in any 1 cylinder is 1 035 kPa (150 psi), the lowest allowable pressure for any other cylinder would be 725 kPa (105 psi). (1 035 x 70% = 725) (150 x 70% = 105). ^ Normal - Compression builds up quickly and evenly to the specified compression for each cylinder. ^ Piston Rings Leaking - Compression is low on the first stroke. Compression builds up with the following strokes, but does not reach normal. Compression improves considerably when you add oil. ^ Valves Leaking - Compression is low on the first stroke. Compression usually does not build up on the following strokes. Compression does not improve much when you add oil. ^ If 2 adjacent cylinders have lower than normal compression, and injecting oil into the cylinders does not increase the compression, the cause may be a head gasket leaking between the cylinders. Page 9021 difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Bosch Connectors (ECM) BOSCH CONNECTORS (ECM) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the assist lever on the top of the connector. Move the assist lever to the forward position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 2501 breakers are used. CIRCUIT BREAKER This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high current is removed. POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) CIRCUIT BREAKER This type greatly increases its resistance when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker will re-close within a second or 2. Circuit Protection - Fuses CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSES The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and examine the element in the fuse for an open (2). If not broken (1), also check for continuity using a DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one of equal current rating. Circuit Protection - Fusible Links CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSIBLE LINKS Page 2598 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) and slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. Page 6698 Release the lower wiredress cover locking tab. Release the upper wiredress cover locking tab. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. Page 5601 Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size. REPAIRING A FUSIBLE LINK IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient overload protection. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. Flat Wire Repairs FLAT WIRE REPAIRS NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced. GMLAN Wiring Repairs GMLAN WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The GM Local Area Network (GMLAN) System requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working on GMLAN connectors and terminals. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items in order to repair the GMLAN wiring: Dura Seal splice sleeves - A wire stripping tool - J 38125-8 Crimping Tool (GM P/N 12085115) - J 38125-5 Ultra Torch Special Tool (GM P/N 12085116) The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. - A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors GMLAN REPAIRS IMPORTANT: When making a repair to any GMLAN network, the original wire length after the repair must be the same length as before the repair. If the network is a twisted pair, the twist must be maintained after the repair is completed. GMLAN has 2 types of networks, low speed and high speed. Low speed GMLAN has a single wire and works at slow speeds. High speed GMLAN has 2 wires in a twisted pair and works at higher speeds. For more information on GMLAN, refer to Data Link Communications Description and Operation. GMLAN CONNECTOR TERMINAL REPAIR IMPORTANT: A service terminal can be used to replace damaged connector terminals for both high speed and low speed GMLAN systems. When making a connector terminal repair on a GMLAN high speed system with twisted pair wires, do not untwist the wires more than necessary to make the repair. The terminals in the GMLAN system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are available in the J-38125. If the individual terminals are damaged on any GMLAN connection, use the appropriate connector repair procedure in order to repair the terminal. GMLAN WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 3759 Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. FCI Connectors FCI CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 8712 3. Use a small flat-bladed tool to gently pry off the dress cover by inserting the tool under the cover opposite the harness side and prying up. 4. Remove the cover. 5. Using a small flat-bladed tool, push on the side of the nose piece retainer while pushing the nose piece forward with your thumb. This will release the terminal position assurance (TPA). 6. Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) into the corresponding terminal release cavity. The release cavities are the 2 center rows of cavities on one half of the connector. Page 4538 7. Pressing the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool in the release cavity of the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and crimper in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (DOOR MODULE) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Side view of connector. View of top of connector. 1. Locate the assist lever and lock on the top of the connector. Page 5416 If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200 DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J 39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected. IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J 39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and maximum (MAX) values measured. 1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of a suspected circuit to the other. 2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J 39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep). IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value in order to record the full change. 5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling the connections or the wiring, test driving, or performing other operations. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions. 6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9. Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist. Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections TESTING FOR INTERMITTENT CONDITIONS AND POOR CONNECTIONS TOOLS REQUIRED - J 35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit - J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit When the condition is not currently present, but is indicated in DTC history, the cause may be intermittent. An intermittent may also be the cause when there is a customer complaint, but the symptom cannot be duplicated. Refer to the Symptom Table of the system that is suspect of causing the condition before trying to locate an intermittent condition. Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the following items: Wiring broken inside the insulation - Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector - Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself, and corrosion in the wire to terminal contact area, etc. - Pierced or damaged insulation can allow moisture to enter the wiring causing corrosion. The conductor can corrode inside the insulation, with little visible evidence. Look for swollen and stiff sections of wire in the suspect circuits. - Wiring which has been pinched, cut, or its insulation rubbed through may cause an intermittent open or short as the bare area touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle. - Wiring that comes in contact with hot or exhaust components - Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required, in order to verify the customer concern. - Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. - Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis and Vehicle Data Recorder operation. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any inline connectors before replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation. Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination, usually in the underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit. Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper adapter. Always use the J 35616 when probing connectors. Other causes of terminal deformation are improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT IN BUSSED ELECTRICAL CENTERS (BEC) Page 5276 Tires/Wheels - Tire Slowly Goes Flat/Warning Light ON Wheels: Customer Interest Tires/Wheels - Tire Slowly Goes Flat/Warning Light ON TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 08-03-10-006C Date: April 27, 2010 Subject: Tire Slowly Goes Flat, Tire Air Loss, Low Tire Pressure Warning Light Illuminated, Aluminum Wheel Bead Seat Corrosion (Clean and Resurface Wheel Bead Seat) Models: 2000-2011 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2003-2009 HUMMER H2 2006-2010 HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 08-03-10-006B (Section 03 - Suspension). Condition Some customers may comment on a tire that slowly loses air pressure over a period of days or weeks. Cause Abrasive elements in the environment may intrude between the tire and wheel at the bead seat. There is always some relative motion between the tire and wheel (when the vehicle is driven) and this motion may cause the abrasive particles to wear the wheel and tire materials. As the wear continues, there may also be intrusion at the tire/wheel interface by corrosive media from the environment. Eventually a path for air develops and a 'slow' leak may ensue. This corrosion may appear on the inboard or outboard bead seating surface of the wheel. This corrosion will not be visible until the tire is dismounted from the wheel. Notice This bulletin specifically addresses issues related to wheel bead seat corrosion that may result in an air leak. For issues related to porosity of the wheel casting that may result in an air leak, please refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 05-03-10-006F - Low Tire Pressure, Leaking Cast Aluminum Wheels (Repair with Adhesive Sealant) Correction In most cases, this type of air loss can be corrected by following the procedure below. Important DO NOT replace a wheel for slow air loss unless you have evaluated and/or tried to repair the wheel with the procedure below. Notice The repair is no longer advised or applicable for chromed aluminum wheels. 1. Remove the wheel and tire assembly for diagnosis. Refer to Tire and Wheel Removal and Installation in SI. 2. After a water dunk tank leak test, if you determine the source of the air leak to be around the bead seat of the wheel, dismount the tire to examine the bead seat. Shown below is a typical area of bead seat corrosion.Typical Location of Bead Seat Corrosion Page 6893 6. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs located on the opposite side of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover at the connector end and pry up. 7. Remove the dress cover. 8. Cut the tie wrap on the wire bundle. 9. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting a small flat-bladed tool into the small slot in the end of the slider and pushing on the TPA until it comes out of the connector. When the TPA exits the opposite side of the connector, gasp the TPA and pull it completely out of the connector. 10. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 8907 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. 4. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front of the connector. Page 2451 - Most Molex connectors will have the Molex logo on the dresscover of the connector. In some cases the connectors may have MX followed by another letter. The third letter indicates where the connector was made. A connector with MXD is a Molex connector made in Detroit. Sumitomo has a unique symbol on their connector and possibly a part number. The symbol is similar to that of a diamond lying on its side, similar to that shown. The logo could appear anywhere but the most common place is at the wire side of the housing. Tyco/AMP has many different and unique connector designs. Some may or may not have identifiable marks on them. Page 4385 6. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs located on the opposite side of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover at the connector end and pry up. 7. Remove the dress cover. 8. Cut the tie wrap on the wire bundle. 9. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting a small flat-bladed tool into the small slot in the end of the slider and pushing on the TPA until it comes out of the connector. When the TPA exits the opposite side of the connector, gasp the TPA and pull it completely out of the connector. 10. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 8123 vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide variety of actions, including: - Wiggling the harness - Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting - Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector - Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation - Relocating a harness or wires All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. Another option is, with the component commanded ON and OFF by the scan tool, move related connectors and wiring and observe the component operation. With the engine running, move related connectors and wiring while monitoring engine operation. If harness or connector movement affects the data displayed, component/system operation, or engine operation, inspect and repair the harness/connections as necessary. You may need to load the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these cases you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide good results as well. There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions, along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the circuit to these kinds of conditions. SALT WATER SPRAY Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture. Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5 percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously. HIGH TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070. Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault condition. The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis. This option does not allow for the same control, however. LOW TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect. If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to -18°C (0°F) from one end and +71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized cooling needs. Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or components in an effort to duplicate the concern. DUPLICATING FAILURE CONDITIONS - If none of the previous tests are successful, attempt to duplicate and/or capture the failure conditions. Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, where applicable, contains the conditions that were present when the DTC set. 1. Review and record Freeze Frame/Failure Records data. 2. Clear the DTCs using the scan tool. 3. Turn the key to OFF and wait 15 seconds. 4. Operate the vehicle under the same conditions that were noted in Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, as closely as possible. The vehicle must also be operating within the Conditions for Running the DTC. Refer to Conditions for Running the DTC in the supporting text if a DTC is being diagnosed. 5. Monitor DTC Status for the DTC being tested. The scan tool will indicate Ran, when the enabling conditions have been satisfied long enough for the DTC to run. The scan tool will also indicate whether the DTC passed or failed. - An alternate method is to drive the vehicle with the DMM connected to a suspected circuit. An abnormal reading on the DMM when the concern occurs, may help you locate the concern. Measuring Frequency Page 3974 8. Apply threadlock to the threads of the bracket bolts. Refer to Sealers, Adhesives, and Lubricants for the correct part number. 9. If necessary, install the ignition coils and bracket to the rocker arm cover. 10. If necessary, install the ignition coil bracket studs to the rocker cover. Tighten the studs to 12 N.m (106 lb in). 11. Install the spark plug wires to the ignition coils. 12. Position the engine harness, if necessary. 13. Install the harness clips. 14. Connect the main electrical connector (1) feeding the ignition coils. 15. Install the CPA lock. 16. Install the A/C compressor hose. Refer to Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement (LH6, LS2) Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement (LL8). Page 5483 6. Gently pry the plastic terminal retainer down and carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (16-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, pull the two connector halves apart. Page 6817 Note The rivet stud and surrounding panel area MUST BE properly refinished PRIOR to the installation of the electrical ground wire terminal and conductive nut to maintain a secure, stable and corrosion-free electrical ground. 11. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and Repair in SI. 12. Allow the refinished repair area to cure sufficiently before removing the protective material applied to the rivet stud threads. 13. Remove the painters tape or equivalent from the rivet stud threads. 14. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, thoroughly clean the rivet stud threads to remove any adhesive and allow to dry. 15. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M6 conductive rivet stud. Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase. 16. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground wire terminal. 17. Install the electrical ground wire terminal to the M6 conductive rivet stud. 18. Select a M6 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 19. Install the M6 conductive nut to the rivet stud and: Tighten Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb in) 20. Verify proper system operation. Parts Information Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use: Warranty Information (Saab Models) Page 2196 Utility/Van Zoning UTILITY/VAN ZONING Page 8165 Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. FCI Connectors FCI CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 3414 7. Pressing the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool in the release cavity of the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and crimper in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (DOOR MODULE) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Side view of connector. View of top of connector. 1. Locate the assist lever and lock on the top of the connector. Page 9083 Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size. REPAIRING A FUSIBLE LINK IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient overload protection. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. Flat Wire Repairs FLAT WIRE REPAIRS NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced. GMLAN Wiring Repairs GMLAN WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The GM Local Area Network (GMLAN) System requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working on GMLAN connectors and terminals. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items in order to repair the GMLAN wiring: Dura Seal splice sleeves - A wire stripping tool - J 38125-8 Crimping Tool (GM P/N 12085115) - J 38125-5 Ultra Torch Special Tool (GM P/N 12085116) The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. - A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors GMLAN REPAIRS IMPORTANT: When making a repair to any GMLAN network, the original wire length after the repair must be the same length as before the repair. If the network is a twisted pair, the twist must be maintained after the repair is completed. GMLAN has 2 types of networks, low speed and high speed. Low speed GMLAN has a single wire and works at slow speeds. High speed GMLAN has 2 wires in a twisted pair and works at higher speeds. For more information on GMLAN, refer to Data Link Communications Description and Operation. GMLAN CONNECTOR TERMINAL REPAIR IMPORTANT: A service terminal can be used to replace damaged connector terminals for both high speed and low speed GMLAN systems. When making a connector terminal repair on a GMLAN high speed system with twisted pair wires, do not untwist the wires more than necessary to make the repair. The terminals in the GMLAN system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are available in the J-38125. If the individual terminals are damaged on any GMLAN connection, use the appropriate connector repair procedure in order to repair the terminal. GMLAN WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 7395 2. Use a small flat-bladed tool to release the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting the tool in the small recess on the side of the connector and pushing up until the TPA releases from the connector body. The TPA should raise just slightly. Do not try to remove the TPA. IMPORTANT: The TPA on this connector cannot be removed unless the terminals are removed first. The TPA will come out of the connector body, but only slightly. When the TPA is slightly raised the terminals can be removed. Using excessive force to remove the TPA with the terminals still in the connector will damage the connector. 3. Repeat the process for the other side of the connector. 4. Ensure that the TPA is in the proper position to remove the terminals. Page 5761 Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Crankshaft Position System Variation Learn Crankshaft Position System Variation Learn 1. Install a scan tool. 2. Monitor the engine control module (ECM) for DTCs with a scan tool. If other DTCs are set, except DTC P0315, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle in Vehicle DTC Information for the applicable DTC that set. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Descriptions 3. Select the crankshaft position (CKP) variation learn procedure with a scan tool. 4. The scan tool instructs you to perform the following: 1. Accelerate to wide open throttle (WOT). 2. Release throttle when fuel cut-off occurs. 3. Observe fuel cut-off for applicable engine. 4. Engine should not accelerate beyond calibrated RPM value. 5. Release throttle immediately if value is exceeded. 6. Block drive wheels. 7. Set parking brake. 8. DO NOT apply brake pedal. 9. Cycle ignition from OFF to ON. 10. Apply and hold brake pedal. 11. Start and idle engine. 12. Turn A/C OFF. 13. Vehicle must remain in Park or Neutral. 14. The scan tool monitors certain component signals to determine if all the conditions are met to continue with the procedure. The scan tool only displays the condition that inhibits the procedure. The scan tool monitors the following components: * CKP sensors activity-If there is a CKP sensor condition, refer to the applicable DTC that set. * Camshaft position (CMP) sensor activity-If there is a CMP sensor condition, refer to the applicable DTC that set. * Engine coolant temperature (ECT)-If the ECT is not warm enough, idle the engine until the engine coolant temperature reaches the correct temperature. 5. Enable the CKP system variation learn procedure with a scan tool. Important: While the learn procedure is in progress, release the throttle immediately when the engine starts to decelerate. The engine control is returned to the operator and the engine responds to throttle position after the learn procedure is complete. 6. Accelerate to WOT. 7. Release when the fuel cut-off occurs. 8. Test in progress 9. The scan tool displays Learn Status: Learned this ignition. If the scan tool indicates that DTC P0315 ran and passed, the CKP variation learn procedure is complete. If the scan tool indicates DTC P0315 failed or did not run, refer to DTC P0315. If any other DTCs set, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle in Vehicle DTC Information for the applicable DTC that set. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Descriptions See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/P Code Charts/P0315 10. Turn OFF the ignition for 30 seconds after the learn procedure is completed successfully. 11. The CKP system variation learn procedure is also required when the following service procedures have been performed, regardless of whether DTC P0315 is set: * A CKP sensor replacement * An engine replacement * A ECM replacement * A harmonic balancer replacement * A crankshaft replacement * Any engine repairs which disturb the CKP sensor relationship Page 4526 4. Slide the dress cover forward and off of the connector. 5. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front and rear of the connector. Page 2455 Depress the locks that are located on both sides of the wiredress cover and pull the lever over and past the locks. View of the connector when released from the component. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the front of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool push down on one of the locking tabs and pull the cover up until the dress cover releases. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. Page 2560 MEASURING FREQUENCY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal. IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM to autorange to an appropriate range. 1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency measured. Measuring Voltage MEASURING VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit. 1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods: - Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. - Turn ON the engine. - Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls. - Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested. 3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The DMM displays the voltage measured at that point. Measuring Voltage Drop MEASURING VOLTAGE DROP NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points. Probing Electrical Connectors PROBING ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS Page 1586 Connector Anatomy Connector Repairs contains a list of all connector repairs. The connector repairs are listed by the connector manufacturer and then by connector type. If the technician cannot identify the manufacturer of the connector, refer to Identifying Connectors below. Knowing the connector manufacturer will assist in finding the correct connector repair from the following list: - Connector Position Assurance Locks - Terminal Position Assurance Locks - Bosch Connectors (0.64) Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) Bosch Connectors (BSK) Bosch Connectors (ECM) - Delphi Connectors (Micro.64) Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) Delphi Connectors (12-Way) - Tyco/AMP Connectors (CM 42-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) Tyco/AMP Connectors (025 Cap) Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) - Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) - Repairing Connector Terminals IDENTIFYING CONNECTORS Knowing the connector manufacturer is helpful when trying to locating the correct connector repair procedure. There are many different connector designs used on GM vehicles and it is sometimes difficult to identify the connector manufacturer. The information in this document should help with the identification of connector manufactures. The following connector manufacturers make most of the connectors found in GM vehicles: AFL/EPC (Alcoa Fujikura Ltd./Engineered Plastics Components) - Bosch - Delphi - FCI (Framatome Connectors International) - JAE (Japan Aviation Electronics) - JST (Japan Solderless Terminals) Page 541 View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. 4. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers CIRCUIT PROTECTION - CIRCUIT BREAKERS A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types of circuit Page 7568 Body Control System Diagram 1 (2 Of 3) Page 8248 View of connector in released position. 4. Disconnect the connector from the component. 5. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Release the rear lower half of the wiredress cover. Page 7343 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. 4. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front of the connector. Page 4609 - In some cases Delphi will actually be printed on the connector. If Delphi is not printed on the connector, look for PED. In both cases there is no specific orientation for Delphi or PED and they can appear anywhere on the connector. - FCI connectors may have the FCI logo on their connectors. The logo is the letters FCI with an "A" above it. - JAE connector have JAE in small letters on their connectors. Page 7370 Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. FCI Connectors FCI CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Service Precautions Power Steering Line/Hose: Service Precautions Power Steering Hose Disconnected Notice Notice: Do not start the vehicle with any power steering gear inlet or outlet hoses disconnected. When disconnected, plug or cap all openings of components. Failure to do so could result in contamination or loss of power steering fluid and damage to the system. Page 1869 Depress the locks that are located on both sides of the wiredress cover and pull the lever over and past the locks. View of the connector when released from the component. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the front of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool push down on one of the locking tabs and pull the cover up until the dress cover releases. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. Page 2003 TERMINAL REMOVAL Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors. 1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA) device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1). 3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 4. Gently pull the cable and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector. 5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal, refer to Terminal Repair. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3. Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector. REINSTALLING TERMINAL 1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly, refer to Wiring Repairs. 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3. Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) DELPHI CONNECTORS (WEATHER PACK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 8039 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry one side of the nose piece up to the pre-stage position. When the nose piece is in the pre-staged position, the nose piece will be raised above the connector body the length of the step in the nose piece. 7. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry the other side of the piece to the pre-stage position. If the nose piece is higher than the first step in the nose piece, gently push down on the nose piece until it meets with resistance from the connector body, you should feel the nose piece click into position. Page 409 MOLEX CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. 2. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. Page 8261 - JST connectors have JST in small letters on their connectors, similar to that above. The location of the logo will vary with the connector size and style. - Kostel has an "LK" with a circle around it. These connector are usually used as a transmissions connection and are currently use on some Cadillac vehicles. Page 1968 IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals. Front probe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the connector. IMPORTANT: When probing female 0.64 terminals, it is important to use the correct adapter. There have been some revisions to the test adapter for 0.64 terminals. The proper adapter for 0.64 terminals is the J 35616-64B which has a gold terminal and a black wire between the base and tip. Failure to use the proper test adapter may result in damage to the terminal being tested and improper diagnosis. NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Page 1913 2. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully push the terminal position assurance (TPA) towards the face of the connector on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA is fragile and may break if not done carefully. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. 3. Use the J 38125-215 tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 7685 Open the harness by removing any tape. 2. Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. 3. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 4. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent american wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 5. Slide a section of high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing down the length of wire to be spliced. Ensure that the shrink tubing will not interfere with the splice procedure. 6. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 7. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. 8. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 9. Insert the wire into the DuraSeal splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 10. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Page 6713 8. Insert the J 38125-213 into the small terminal release hole on the nose piece and gently pull on the back of the wire. 9. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Repairing Connector Terminals REPAIRING CONNECTOR TERMINALS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following: Push to Seat terminals - Pull to Seat terminals Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your terminal repair. The J-38125 contains further information. 1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.For cable seal terminals, remove the seal. 2. Apply the correct cable seal per gage size of the wire, if used.Slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation removal. 3. Remove the insulation. 4. For sealed terminals only, align the seal with the end of the cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal.For sealed terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal. 6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.For sealed terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable. 8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals excepting Micro-Pack 100.64 size. Soldering Micro-Pack 100 World terminals may damage the terminal. Sumitomo Connectors SUMITOMO CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 4917 Depress the locks that are located on both sides of the wiredress cover and pull the lever over and past the locks. View of the connector when released from the component. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the front of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool push down on one of the locking tabs and pull the cover up until the dress cover releases. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. Page 5557 The first connector design of the Micro-Pack 100W (1) has a white connector interface that holds the terminals. The second design of the Micro-Pack 100W (2) has a gray interface to hold the terminals. Also, the first design has terminal cavities that are further apart (3 mm centerline) and offset from the other row of terminal cavities in the connector. The second design has terminals cavities that are closer together (2.54 mm centerline) and aligned vertically. One other way to identify the second design is the thin strip of material that runs along the outside of the cavities. IMPORTANT: There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W terminals which are very similar. Ensure that you have the correct terminal before crimping the new terminal to the wire. The first design connector uses the longer terminal (1) that has a raised area in front of the recess in the terminal. The second design connector uses the shorter terminal without the raised area. Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro-Pack 100W connectors. Some Micro-Pack 100W connector disassembly procedures will vary. Use this procedure as a guide. 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 6724 3. Ensure that the terminal release tang access panel is in the correct location to access the terminals. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) into the terminal release tang access slot located behind the access panel of the connector and press down on the terminal while carefully pulling the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Tyco/AMP Connectors (0.25 Cap) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (025 CAP) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component by pressing down on the connector position assurance (CPA). Page 4493 IMPORTANT: Ensure that the dress cover and connector body are both in the released position before reassembling. Failure to do so may cause damage to the connector and component. Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (0.64) BOSCH CONNECTORS (0.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While pressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock until the lever is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Pull the rubber boot that covers the wires back to expose the end of the connector dress cover. 4. Place the connector locking lever in the center of the connector. 5. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs that are on the wire end of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover and connector body and pry up. Page 1385 2. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully push the terminal position assurance (TPA) towards the face of the connector on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA is fragile and may break if not done carefully. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. 3. Use the J 38125-215 tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 5225 2. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully push the terminal position assurance (TPA) towards the face of the connector on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA is fragile and may break if not done carefully. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. 3. Use the J 38125-215 tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 8857 Open the harness by removing any tape. 2. Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. 3. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 4. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent american wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 5. Slide a section of high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing down the length of wire to be spliced. Ensure that the shrink tubing will not interfere with the splice procedure. 6. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 7. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. 8. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 9. Insert the wire into the DuraSeal splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 10. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Page 2939 Step 1 - Step 6 Page 641 Note All pictures must be sent as a.jpg file. 27. E-mail a copy of the screenshot to [email protected]. In the subject line of the e-mail include the phrase "V8 Cal" as well as the complete VIN and Dealer BAC. In the body of the e-mail, include the VIN, mileage, R.O. number and BAC. Include a brief description of the customer concern and cause of the concern. Note The dealer will receive an e-mail reply after the calibrations have been validated. The e-mail reply will advise the dealer if the calibrations are OEM. 28. Allow two hours for the PQC to verify the calibrations and set up the case details. ‹› If the PQC determines that the calibrations ARE aftermarket calibrations, DO NOT contact GM Technical Assistance to discuss warranty concerns on the aftermarket calibrations. ALL questions and concerns about warranty should be directed to the dealers Fixed Operations Manager (FOM), (Warranty Manager (WM) in Canada). 29. You may call the PQC two hours after submitting the e-mail for authorization to replace the assembly. This will provide them time to receive, review and set up a case on the request. Please be prepared to provide all the usual documentation that is normally required when requesting an assembly authorization from the PQC. Warranty Information - The Dealership Service Management must be involved in any situation that would justify the use of labor operation Z1111. - Notify the Fixed Operations Manager (FOM) (Warranty Manager (WM) in Canada) of the situation. - All claims will have to be routed to the FOM (WM in Canada) for approval. - Please refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 09-00-89-016, Labor Operation Z1111 - Suspected Tampering or Vehicle Modifications for important information. For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 5148 Engine Control Module: Diagnostic Aids Arrows and Symbols Arrows and Symbols This Service Data uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations. Arrows and Symbols 1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow Basic Knowledge Required GENERAL ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures contained in the service manual. You should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current (amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram, as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. Decimal and Metric Equivalents Decimal and Metric Equivalents Page 8350 under pressure if the radiator cap or the surge tank cap is removed while the engine and radiator are still hot. 4. Remove the surge tank fill cap from the surge tank or the coolant pressure cap from the radiator. 5. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle in SI. 6. Place a clean drain pan under the radiator drain cock or under the lower radiator hose depending on the vehicle. Refer to Cooling System Draining and Filling in SI. 7. Loosen the radiator drain cock if equipped or use J 38185 clamp pliers and reposition the clamp on the lower radiator hose at the radiator. 8. Remove the end of the lower radiator hose from the radiator. 9. Drain the engine coolant sufficiently below the level of the ECT sensor. 10. Close the radiator drain cock or connect the lower radiator hose at the radiator. 11. Use the J 38185 clamp pliers to place the clamp into the original position on the hose. 12. Lower the vehicle. 13. Disconnect the wiring harness connector from the ECT sensor (2). 14. Remove the ECT sensor (1) from the front of the cylinder head. 15. Remove the corresponding size plug at the rear of the OTHER cylinder head. 16. Coat the threads of the ECT sensor with sealer. Use GM P/N 12346004 (Canadian P/N 10953480) or an equivalent. 17. Install the ECT sensor in the hole of the cylinder head where the plug was removed. Tighten Tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb ft). 18. Coat the threads of the plug with sealer. Use GM P/N 12346004 (Canadian P/N 10953480) or an equivalent. 19. Install the plug in the hole of the cylinder head where the ECT sensor was removed Tighten Tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb ft). Important Leave enough wire attached to the ECT sensor harness connector in order to create manageable splices that are at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splice. Page 1057 Driver Door Module (DDM) Page 5716 MOLEX CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. 2. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. Engine - Valve Lifter Tick Noise At Start Up Oil Filter: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Valve Lifter Tick Noise At Start Up TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 10-06-01-007C Date: February 09, 2011 Subject: Active Fuel Management (AFM) Engine, Valve Lifter Tick Noise at Start Up When Engine Has Been Off for 2 Hours or More (Evaluate Noise and/or Replace Valve Lifters) Models: 2007 Buick Rainier 2009 Buick LaCrosse Super, Allure Super (Canada Only) 2007 Cadillac Escalade Built Prior to April 1, 2006 with 6.2L Engine RPO L92 (These engines were built with AFM Hardware but the AFM system was disabled) 2010-2011 Cadillac Escalade, Escalade ESV, Escalade EXT 2007 Chevrolet Monte Carlo 2007-2009 Chevrolet Impala 2007-2011 Chevrolet Avalanche, Silverado, Suburban, Tahoe, TrailBlazer, TrailBlazer EXT 2010-2011 Chevrolet Camaro SS 2007-2011 GMC Envoy, Envoy XL, Sierra, Yukon, Yukon Denali, Yukon XL, Yukon XL Denali 2007-2008 Pontiac Grand Prix 2008-2009 Pontiac G8 2007-2009 Saab 9-7X Equipped with AFM (Active Fuel Management) and V8 Engine RPO L76, L94, L99, LC9, LFA, LH6, LMG, LS4, LY5 or LZ1 Attention: This bulletin only applies to the AFM V8 engines listed above. It DOES NOT apply to Non-AFM Engines. If you are dealing with a Non-AFM engine that is experiencing a similar noise, please refer to Engine Mechanical > Diagnostic Information and Procedures > Symptoms in SI. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add models. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 10-06-01-007B (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). Condition Some customers may comment on an engine valve lifter tick noise that occurs after the engine has been shut off for at least two hours. The tick noise may last from two seconds to ten minutes. Cause This condition may be caused by any of the following: - Aerated oil in the valve lifter body, resulting in the valve lifter being unable to purge the air quickly. - A low engine oil level or incorrect oil viscosity. - Dirty or contaminated oil. - A low internal valve lifter oil reservoir level. - Debris in the valve lifter. - A high valve lifter leak down rate. Correction If the SI diagnostics do not isolate the cause of this valve lifter tick noise and normal oil pressure is noted during the concern, perform the following steps: 1. Inspect the engine oil condition and level. Refer to Owner Manual > Service and Appearance Care > Checking Things Under the Hood > Description and Operation > Engine Oil in SI. ‹› If the engine oil is more than one quart low, an incorrect oil viscosity is being used or if poor quality/contamination is observed, change the oil and filter. Note Page 4336 Contamination Mixing conventional green coolant with DEX-COOL(R) will degrade the service interval from 5 yrs./150,000 miles (240,000 km) to 2 yrs./30,000 miles (50,000 km) if left in the contaminated condition. If contamination occurs, the cooling system must be flushed twice immediately and re-filled with a 50/50 mixture of DEX-COOL(R) and clean water in order to preserve the enhanced properties and extended service interval of DEX-COOL(R). After 5 years/150,000 miles (240,000 km) After 5 yrs/150,000 miles (240,000 km), the coolant should be changed, preferably using a coolant exchanger. If the vehicle was originally equipped with DEX-COOL(R) and has not had problems with contamination from non-DEX-COOL(R) coolants, then the service interval remains the same, and the coolant does not need to be changed for another 5 yrs/150,000 miles (240,000 km) Equipment (Coolant Exchangers) The preferred method of performing coolant replacement is to use a coolant exchanger. A coolant exchanger can replace virtually all of the old coolant with new coolant. Coolant exchangers can be used to perform coolant replacement without spillage, and facilitate easy waste collection. They can also be used to lower the coolant level in a vehicle to allow for less messy servicing of cooling system components. It is recommended that you use a coolant exchanger with a vacuum feature facilitates removing trapped air from the cooling system. This is a substantial time savings over repeatedly thermo cycling the vehicle and topping-off the radiator. The vacuum feature also allows venting of a hot system to relieve system pressure. Approved coolant exchangers are available through the GMDE (General Motors Dealer Equipment) program. For refilling a cooling system that has been partially or fully drained for repairs other than coolant replacement, the Vac-N-Fill Coolant Refill Tool (GE-47716) is recommended to facilitate removal of trapped air from the cooling system during refill. Disclaimer Page 1583 6. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs located on the opposite side of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover at the connector end and pry up. 7. Remove the dress cover. 8. Cut the tie wrap on the wire bundle. 9. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting a small flat-bladed tool into the small slot in the end of the slider and pushing on the TPA until it comes out of the connector. When the TPA exits the opposite side of the connector, gasp the TPA and pull it completely out of the connector. 10. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 1386 View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. 4. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers CIRCUIT PROTECTION - CIRCUIT BREAKERS A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types of circuit Page 8774 Page 5880 Open the harness by removing any tape. 2. Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. 3. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 4. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent american wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 5. Slide a section of high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing down the length of wire to be spliced. Ensure that the shrink tubing will not interfere with the splice procedure. 6. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 7. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. 8. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 9. Insert the wire into the DuraSeal splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 10. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Page 1024 Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Diagrams Immobilizer Connector End Views Hood Ajar Switch (UA2) Page 6618 Crankshaft Position Sensor: Connector Views Engine Controls Connector End Views Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor Page 876 7. The illustration above identifies the entry canal where the terminal release tool will be inserted, and the terminal cavity. - Terminal (1) - Entry Canal (2) 8. Insert the J-38125-553 (15315247) tool into the entry canal and pry up on the terminal retainer. The terminal retainer is a small plastic piece on the top of the terminal. The terminal retainer must be held up while the terminal is pulled out of the connector. Drive Belt Tensioner Replacement - Accessory Drive Belt Tensioner: Service and Repair Drive Belt Tensioner Replacement - Accessory Drive Belt Tensioner Replacement - Accessory Removal Procedure 1. Remove the accessory drive belt. Refer to Drive Belt Replacement - Accessory. 2. Remove the drive belt tensioner bolts. 3. Remove the drive belt tensioner. Installation Procedure 1. Install the drive belt tensioner. 2. Install the drive belt tensioner bolts. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 3. Tighten the drive belt tensioner bolts. Tighten the bolts to 50 N.m (37 lb ft). 4. Install the accessory drive belt. Refer to Drive Belt Replacement - Accessory. Page 8915 - In some cases Delphi will actually be printed on the connector. If Delphi is not printed on the connector, look for PED. In both cases there is no specific orientation for Delphi or PED and they can appear anywhere on the connector. - FCI connectors may have the FCI logo on their connectors. The logo is the letters FCI with an "A" above it. - JAE connector have JAE in small letters on their connectors. Page 5878 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Start in the middle and gradually move the heat barrel to the open ends of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Heated Oxygen Sensor Wiring Repairs HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being obstructed. If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. - Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks, etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire. - Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance. - To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector. Page 7352 - JST connectors have JST in small letters on their connectors, similar to that above. The location of the logo will vary with the connector size and style. - Kostel has an "LK" with a circle around it. These connector are usually used as a transmissions connection and are currently use on some Cadillac vehicles. Page 4966 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Start in the middle and gradually move the heat barrel to the open ends of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Heated Oxygen Sensor Wiring Repairs HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being obstructed. If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. - Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks, etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire. - Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance. - To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector. Page 5210 5. Once the nose piece retainers are relaxed, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should raise slightly. 6. On the opposite side of the nose piece, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should release completely. If the nose piece does not come off, repeat the procedure on the opposite side. Page 6474 7. Pressing the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool in the release cavity of the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and crimper in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (DOOR MODULE) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Side view of connector. View of top of connector. 1. Locate the assist lever and lock on the top of the connector. Page 8824 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully raise the TPA on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA cannot be removed from the connector while there are terminals present in the connector body. View of the TPA when removed from the connector body. 4. Use the J 38125-12A tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the left side of the terminal release cavity as shown in the graphic. Use the tool to move the terminal release to the right with a gentle prying motion. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 5793 Page 5299 View of connector in released position. 4. Disconnect the connector from the component. 5. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Release the rear lower half of the wiredress cover. Page 6431 11. Insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) into the 2 triangular cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 12. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE 1. Prior to installation the terminal must be aligned so the (1) coding lugs align with the (2) coding grooves on the connector. 2. Once the terminal is aligned, slide the terminal into the cavity until the retainer has engaged in the cavity of the connector. 3. Slide the TPA in the connector body and seat it using a small flat bladed tool. The TPA is seated when it is flush with the contact housing. 4. Secure the wires to the connector body using a tie wrap and replace the dress cover and grommet. Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) BOSCH CONNECTORS (2.8 JPT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Pull out the slider on the connector position assurance (CPA) until it is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 5602 If a wire is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm, etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except coaxial. - Do not use the DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent American wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 729 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Kostal Connectors KOSTAL CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 5820 5. Insert the J 38125-557 (GM P/N 12122378) into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 6. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Connector Position Assurance Locks CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of the connector. CPAs are used in various connectors throughout the vehicle. CPAs are also used in all SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals, of the connector. Connector Repairs CONNECTOR REPAIRS Page 8660 Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. For connectors with a bolt in the dress cover, turn the bolt counterclockwise to remove the connector from the component. 2. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. Page 6226 The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors. 1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position. 4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool J 38125-10A (GM P/N 12014012-1) into the front (mating end) of the connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal through the back of the connector (2). IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector. 6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. 7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily. 10. Perform system check. Delphi Connectors (12 Way) DELPHI CONNECTORS (12-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. Diagram Information and Instructions Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay: Diagram Information and Instructions Electrical Symbols Page 6223 pulling it through. This will prevent damage to the internal seals of the connector. Once the terminal is pushed out of the connector, cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible and pull the wire through the connector. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE The Micro-Pack 100W connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool was developed to crimp Micro-Pack 100W terminals. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 2. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert the terminal into the crimp tool until the core wings are flush with the anvil on the crimp tool. Be sure that the wings are pointed toward the crimp tool former and release the spring locator. The locator will hold the terminal in place. Inspect the alignment of the terminal wings with the crimp tool former. If the terminal wings are wider than the crimp tool former, remove the terminal and bend the terminal wings in slightly. 5. Place stripped wire into terminal. 6. Crimp the new terminal to the wire. If a jam occurs, press the emergency release to open applicator. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire perform the following procedure in order to replace Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. Page 334 For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 2062 Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Adjustments Park/Neutral Position Switch Adjustment Important: ^ The following procedure is for vehicles that have not had the switch removed or replaced. If the switch has been removed or replaced, refer to Park/Neutral Position Switch Replacement for the proper adjustment procedure. ^ Apply the parking brake. ^ The engine must start in the P (Park) or N (Neutral) positions only. ^ Check the switch for proper operation. If adjustment is required, proceed as follows: 1. Place the transmission range selector in the N (Neutral) position. 2. With an assistant in the drivers seat, raise the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 3. Loosen the park/neutral position switch mounting bolts. 4. With the vehicle in the N (Neutral) position, rotate the switch while the assistant attempts to start the engine. 5. Following a successful start, turn the engine OFF. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 6. Tighten the bolts securing the switch to the transmission. Tighten the bolts to 25 N.m (18 lb ft). 7. Lower the vehicle. 8. Check the switch for proper operation. The engine must start in the P (Park) or N (Neutral) positions only. 9. Replace the park/neutral position switch if proper operation can not be achieved. Refer to Park/Neutral Position Switch Replacement. Page 8506 Utility/Van Zoning UTILITY/VAN ZONING Page 3526 Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Sensor Replacement Tire Pressure Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Raise the vehicle on a suitable support. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 2. Remove the tire/wheel assembly from the vehicle. Refer to Tire and Wheel Removal and Installation. Important: Before the tire is removed from the wheel, note the following items to avoid tire pressure sensor damage upon tire dismounting. ^ Place the sensors cap and valve on a dry clean surface after removal. The cap is aluminum and the valve is nickel plated to prevent corrosion and are not to be substituted with a cap or valve made of any other material. ^ When separating the tire bead from the wheel, position the bead breaking fixture 90 degrees from the valve stem. ^ Position the mounting/dismounting head so the tire iron, or pry bar can be inserted slightly clockwise of the sensor body when prying the tire bead up and over the mounting/dismounting head. ^ Using the tire machine, rotate the tire/wheel assembly clockwise when transferring the tire bead to the outside of the wheel rim. ^ Repeat items for inner bead. Remove the tire from the wheel. Refer to Tire Mounting and Dismounting. Important: If any tire sealant is noted upon tire dismounting, remove all residual liquid sealant from the inside of the tire and wheel surfaces. 3. Remove the tire pressure sensor nut. 4. Remove the tire pressure sensor. Installation Procedure 1. Clean any dirt or debris from the grommet sealing area. 2. Insert the sensor in the wheel hole with the air passage facing away from the wheel. Page 6015 Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size. REPAIRING A FUSIBLE LINK IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient overload protection. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. Flat Wire Repairs FLAT WIRE REPAIRS NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced. GMLAN Wiring Repairs GMLAN WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The GM Local Area Network (GMLAN) System requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working on GMLAN connectors and terminals. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items in order to repair the GMLAN wiring: Dura Seal splice sleeves - A wire stripping tool - J 38125-8 Crimping Tool (GM P/N 12085115) - J 38125-5 Ultra Torch Special Tool (GM P/N 12085116) The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. - A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors GMLAN REPAIRS IMPORTANT: When making a repair to any GMLAN network, the original wire length after the repair must be the same length as before the repair. If the network is a twisted pair, the twist must be maintained after the repair is completed. GMLAN has 2 types of networks, low speed and high speed. Low speed GMLAN has a single wire and works at slow speeds. High speed GMLAN has 2 wires in a twisted pair and works at higher speeds. For more information on GMLAN, refer to Data Link Communications Description and Operation. GMLAN CONNECTOR TERMINAL REPAIR IMPORTANT: A service terminal can be used to replace damaged connector terminals for both high speed and low speed GMLAN systems. When making a connector terminal repair on a GMLAN high speed system with twisted pair wires, do not untwist the wires more than necessary to make the repair. The terminals in the GMLAN system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are available in the J-38125. If the individual terminals are damaged on any GMLAN connection, use the appropriate connector repair procedure in order to repair the terminal. GMLAN WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 8709 5. Once the nose piece retainers are relaxed, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should raise slightly. 6. On the opposite side of the nose piece, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should release completely. If the nose piece does not come off, repeat the procedure on the opposite side. Engine - MIL ON P0116/P1400 Set In Very Cold Temps Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Customer Interest Engine - MIL ON P0116/P1400 Set In Very Cold Temps TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 10-06-04-008A Date: January 24, 2011 Subject: Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) Illuminated at Very Cold Ambient Temperatures When Using Engine Coolant Heater, DTC P0116 and/or P1400 Set (Relocate Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor and Engine Coolant Heater Cord) Models: 2006-2007 Buick Rainier 2009 Buick LaCrosse Super, Allure Super (Canada Only) 2006-2010 Cadillac Escalade 2006-2007 Chevrolet Monte Carlo 2006-2009 Chevrolet Impala SS, TrailBlazer 2006-2010 Chevrolet Avalanche, Express, Silverado Tahoe 2006-2009 GMC Envoy 2006-2010 GMC Savana, Sierra, Yukon 2006-2008 Pontiac Grand Prix 2006-2009 Saab 9-7X Equipped with V8 Engine RPO LC9, LH6, LH8, LH9, L76, LS2, LS4, LFA, LZ1, L92, L94, L9H or L20, L96, LMF, LMG, LY2, LY5, LY6 Please Refer to GMVIS Attention: To properly correct this condition, you must follow both of the procedures to relocate the ECT sensor and the engine coolant heater cord. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add cast iron block engine RPOs and to update the Warranty Information coverage period. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 10-06-04-008 (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). Condition Some customers may comment that the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) illuminates after starting the vehicle when they were using the engine coolant heater in very cold ambient temperatures. This usually occurs in a range of -23 to -40°C (-10 to -40°F) or colder. The technician may observe on a scan tool DTC P0116 and/or P1400 set as Current or in History. Cause This condition may be caused by the engine control module (ECM) determining that the ignition OFF time requirement has been met at start-up and interpreting the temperature difference between the engine coolant temperature (ECT) sensor and the intake air temperature (IAT) sensor as being outside of a calibrated range. Correction Important DO NOT replace the ECM for this condition. Relocating the ECT Sensor 1. Turn ON the ignition with the engine OFF. 2. Perform the diagnostic system check - vehicle. Refer to Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle in SI. ‹› If DTC P0116 and/or P1400 are set and the customer WAS using the engine coolant heater, proceed to Step 3. ‹› If DTC P0116 and/or P1400 are set and the customer WAS NOT using the engine coolant heater, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle in SI. 3. Turn OFF the ignition. Warning To avoid being burned, do not remove the radiator cap or surge tank cap while the engine is hot. The cooling system will release scalding fluid and steam Page 3742 - Most Molex connectors will have the Molex logo on the dresscover of the connector. In some cases the connectors may have MX followed by another letter. The third letter indicates where the connector was made. A connector with MXD is a Molex connector made in Detroit. Sumitomo has a unique symbol on their connector and possibly a part number. The symbol is similar to that of a diamond lying on its side, similar to that shown. The logo could appear anywhere but the most common place is at the wire side of the housing. Tyco/AMP has many different and unique connector designs. Some may or may not have identifiable marks on them. Page 5361 2. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully push the terminal position assurance (TPA) towards the face of the connector on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA is fragile and may break if not done carefully. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. 3. Use the J 38125-215 tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 5303 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. 4. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front of the connector. Page 3313 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Start in the middle and gradually move the heat barrel to the open ends of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Heated Oxygen Sensor Wiring Repairs HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being obstructed. If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. - Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks, etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire. - Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance. - To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector. Page 357 vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide variety of actions, including: - Wiggling the harness - Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting - Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector - Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation - Relocating a harness or wires All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. Another option is, with the component commanded ON and OFF by the scan tool, move related connectors and wiring and observe the component operation. With the engine running, move related connectors and wiring while monitoring engine operation. If harness or connector movement affects the data displayed, component/system operation, or engine operation, inspect and repair the harness/connections as necessary. You may need to load the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these cases you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide good results as well. There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions, along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the circuit to these kinds of conditions. SALT WATER SPRAY Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture. Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5 percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously. HIGH TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070. Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault condition. The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis. This option does not allow for the same control, however. LOW TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect. If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to -18°C (0°F) from one end and +71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized cooling needs. Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or components in an effort to duplicate the concern. DUPLICATING FAILURE CONDITIONS - If none of the previous tests are successful, attempt to duplicate and/or capture the failure conditions. Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, where applicable, contains the conditions that were present when the DTC set. 1. Review and record Freeze Frame/Failure Records data. 2. Clear the DTCs using the scan tool. 3. Turn the key to OFF and wait 15 seconds. 4. Operate the vehicle under the same conditions that were noted in Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, as closely as possible. The vehicle must also be operating within the Conditions for Running the DTC. Refer to Conditions for Running the DTC in the supporting text if a DTC is being diagnosed. 5. Monitor DTC Status for the DTC being tested. The scan tool will indicate Ran, when the enabling conditions have been satisfied long enough for the DTC to run. The scan tool will also indicate whether the DTC passed or failed. - An alternate method is to drive the vehicle with the DMM connected to a suspected circuit. An abnormal reading on the DMM when the concern occurs, may help you locate the concern. Measuring Frequency Wheels - Chrome Wheel Brake Dust Accumulation/Pitting Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels - Chrome Wheel Brake Dust Accumulation/Pitting Bulletin No.: 04-03-10-012B Date: February 01, 2008 INFORMATION Subject: Pitting and Brake Dust on Chrome wheels Models: 2008 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2008 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 04-03-10-012A (Section 03 - Suspension). Analysis of Returned Wheels Chrome wheels returned under the New Vehicle Limited Warranty for pitting concerns have recently been evaluated. This condition is usually most severe in the vent (or window) area of the front wheels. This "pitting" may actually be brake dust that has been allowed to accumulate on the wheel. The longer this accumulation builds up, the more difficult it is to remove. Cleaning the Wheels In all cases, the returned wheels could be cleaned to their original condition using GM Vehicle Care Cleaner Wax, P/N 12377966 (in Canada, P/N 10952905). When using this product, you should confine your treatment to the areas of the wheel that show evidence of the brake dust build-up. This product is only for use on chromed steel or chromed aluminum wheels. Parts Information Warranty Information Wheel replacement for this condition is NOT applicable under the terms of the New Vehicle Limited Warranty. Disclaimer Page 6477 6. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by pressing on the tang. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (SENSOR) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) tool into the cavity on the lower right hand face of the connector until the terminal release tang access panel slides over. Page 6703 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. JST Connectors JST CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, remove the connector from the component. Page 8782 If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200 DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J 39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected. IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J 39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and maximum (MAX) values measured. 1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of a suspected circuit to the other. 2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J 39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep). IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value in order to record the full change. 5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling the connections or the wiring, test driving, or performing other operations. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions. 6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9. Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist. Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections TESTING FOR INTERMITTENT CONDITIONS AND POOR CONNECTIONS TOOLS REQUIRED - J 35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit - J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit When the condition is not currently present, but is indicated in DTC history, the cause may be intermittent. An intermittent may also be the cause when there is a customer complaint, but the symptom cannot be duplicated. Refer to the Symptom Table of the system that is suspect of causing the condition before trying to locate an intermittent condition. Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the following items: Wiring broken inside the insulation - Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector - Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself, and corrosion in the wire to terminal contact area, etc. - Pierced or damaged insulation can allow moisture to enter the wiring causing corrosion. The conductor can corrode inside the insulation, with little visible evidence. Look for swollen and stiff sections of wire in the suspect circuits. - Wiring which has been pinched, cut, or its insulation rubbed through may cause an intermittent open or short as the bare area touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle. - Wiring that comes in contact with hot or exhaust components - Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required, in order to verify the customer concern. - Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. - Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis and Vehicle Data Recorder operation. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any inline connectors before replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation. Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination, usually in the underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit. Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper adapter. Always use the J 35616 when probing connectors. Other causes of terminal deformation are improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT IN BUSSED ELECTRICAL CENTERS (BEC) Page 3265 4. Once the front 2 locks are unlocked, lift the front of the dress cover and pull it forward. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the small slot on the TPA and pushing down until the TPA releases. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to angle or rock the J 38125-21 tool when inserting it into the connector or the tool may break. Insert the J 38125-21 (GM P/N 15381651-2) tool into the round canal between the terminals cavities at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to repair Micro 64 connector terminals. The Micro 64 connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-64 (M jaw) was developed to crimp Micro 64 terminals. The J 38125-64 crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. The J 38125-64 crimping tool is also designed to crimp both the wire and the insulation at the same time. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro 64 terminals. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. 1. Cut the wire as close to the damaged terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. Page 9030 - In some cases Delphi will actually be printed on the connector. If Delphi is not printed on the connector, look for PED. In both cases there is no specific orientation for Delphi or PED and they can appear anywhere on the connector. - FCI connectors may have the FCI logo on their connectors. The logo is the letters FCI with an "A" above it. - JAE connector have JAE in small letters on their connectors. Page 1228 Ambient Light Sensor (With RPO Code CJ3) Page 8913 Connector Anatomy Connector Repairs contains a list of all connector repairs. The connector repairs are listed by the connector manufacturer and then by connector type. If the technician cannot identify the manufacturer of the connector, refer to Identifying Connectors below. Knowing the connector manufacturer will assist in finding the correct connector repair from the following list: - Connector Position Assurance Locks - Terminal Position Assurance Locks - Bosch Connectors (0.64) Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) Bosch Connectors (BSK) Bosch Connectors (ECM) - Delphi Connectors (Micro.64) Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) Delphi Connectors (12-Way) - Tyco/AMP Connectors (CM 42-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) Tyco/AMP Connectors (025 Cap) Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) - Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) - Repairing Connector Terminals IDENTIFYING CONNECTORS Knowing the connector manufacturer is helpful when trying to locating the correct connector repair procedure. There are many different connector designs used on GM vehicles and it is sometimes difficult to identify the connector manufacturer. The information in this document should help with the identification of connector manufactures. The following connector manufacturers make most of the connectors found in GM vehicles: AFL/EPC (Alcoa Fujikura Ltd./Engineered Plastics Components) - Bosch - Delphi - FCI (Framatome Connectors International) - JAE (Japan Aviation Electronics) - JST (Japan Solderless Terminals) Page 7620 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. 4. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front of the connector. Page 3671 Wheel Fastener: Description and Operation Metric Wheel Nuts and Bolts Description Metric wheel/nuts and bolts are identified in the following way: ^ The wheel/nut has the word Metric stamped on the face. ^ The letter M is stamped on the end of the wheel bolt. The thread sizes of metric wheel/nuts and the bolts are indicated by the following example: M12 x 1.5. ^ M = Metric ^ 12 = Diameter in millimeters ^ 1.5 = Millimeters gap per thread Page 3319 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the DuraSeal splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of a connector. CPAs are used in all SIR System connectors and also in some connectors of other systems. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals of a connection. TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE CLIPS IMPORTANT: When making a splice in an area that may be exposed to moisture use a crimp and seal splice sleeve instead of a Splice Clip. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. Page 1463 TERMINAL REMOVAL Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors. 1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA) device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1). 3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 4. Gently pull the cable and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector. 5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal, refer to Terminal Repair. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3. Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector. REINSTALLING TERMINAL 1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly, refer to Wiring Repairs. 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3. Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) DELPHI CONNECTORS (WEATHER PACK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 7044 The first connector design of the Micro-Pack 100W (1) has a white connector interface that holds the terminals. The second design of the Micro-Pack 100W (2) has a gray interface to hold the terminals. Also, the first design has terminal cavities that are further apart (3 mm centerline) and offset from the other row of terminal cavities in the connector. The second design has terminals cavities that are closer together (2.54 mm centerline) and aligned vertically. One other way to identify the second design is the thin strip of material that runs along the outside of the cavities. IMPORTANT: There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W terminals which are very similar. Ensure that you have the correct terminal before crimping the new terminal to the wire. The first design connector uses the longer terminal (1) that has a raised area in front of the recess in the terminal. The second design connector uses the shorter terminal without the raised area. Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro-Pack 100W connectors. Some Micro-Pack 100W connector disassembly procedures will vary. Use this procedure as a guide. 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 6883 Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested: - Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. - Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a component or to other harnesses. - If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A TEST LAMP TOOLS REQUIRED J 35616-200 Test Light - Probe Kit NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminate even though voltage is present. The J 35616-200 is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair of leads. To properly operate this tool use the following procedures. When testing for voltage: 1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested. When testing for ground: 1. Attach one lead to battery positive voltage. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where ground should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is ground at the point being tested. Using Connector Test Adapters USING CONNECTOR TEST ADAPTERS NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Using Fused Jumper Wires USING FUSED JUMPER WIRES TOOLS REQUIRED J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged. The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested. AFL/ECP Connectors AFL/EPC CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 1757 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 513 2. Locate the two indents of the terminal position assurance (TPA) located on the bottom of the connector body. Page 5179 View of a typical Micro 64 connector. Depress the lock and pull the lever over and past the lock. Page 530 2. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 3278 REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. The release tab is located on the top of the wiredress cover. View of connector in released position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Page 7879 Body Control Module: Service and Repair Liftgate Control Module Replacement LIFTGATE CONTROL MODULE REPLACEMENT REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Remove the liftgate trim panel. 2. Disconnect the electrical connectors (3) from the module as necessary. 3. Remove the bolts that retain the module to the liftgate. 4. Remove the module from the liftgate. INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 1. Install the module to the liftgate. 2. NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice. Install the bolts that retain the module to the liftgate. Tighten the bolts to 10 N.m (89 lb in). 3. Connect the electrical connectors (3) as necessary. 4. Install the liftgate trim panel. 5. Program the liftgate control module. Refer to Control Module References. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Page 1375 2. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 4474 Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Page 447 US English/Metric Conversion US English/Metric Conversion Page 6337 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Ensure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the Terminal Removal Procedure. Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PULL TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL If the terminal is visibly damaged or is suspected of having a faulty connection, the terminal should be replaced. Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors: 1. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) device and/or the secondary lock. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component or separate the connectors for in-line connectors. 3. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device. 4. Insert the proper pick or removal tool into the front of the connector body. 5. IMPORTANT: On connectors with more than one terminal the service loop may not be large enough to remove the terminal and crimp on a new one. If the terminal wire does not have a large enough service loop for removal, cut the wire 5 cm (2 in) behind the connector before removal. Grasp the wire at the back of the connector body and gently push the terminal out the front of the connector body. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. If the wire needed to be cut in order to remove the terminal, gently push a small length of the same size wire through the back of the connector cavity until there is enough wire exposed in order to crimp on a new terminal. If the wire was not cut, cut the existing wire as close to the old terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 4. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. TERMINAL INSTALLATION 1. Align the terminal and pull the wire from the back of the connector in order to seat the terminal. 2. If necessary, cut the new wire to proper length and splice with existing circuit. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. 3. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply dielectric grease to the connector. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PUSH TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 1493 2. Use a small flat-bladed tool to release the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting the tool in the small recess on the side of the connector and pushing up until the TPA releases from the connector body. The TPA should raise just slightly. Do not try to remove the TPA. IMPORTANT: The TPA on this connector cannot be removed unless the terminals are removed first. The TPA will come out of the connector body, but only slightly. When the TPA is slightly raised the terminals can be removed. Using excessive force to remove the TPA with the terminals still in the connector will damage the connector. 3. Repeat the process for the other side of the connector. 4. Ensure that the TPA is in the proper position to remove the terminals. Page 6653 All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system. Page 8792 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. 4. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front of the connector. Page 7581 Information Bus: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures Symptoms - Data Communications SYMPTOMS - DATA COMMUNICATIONS IMPORTANT: The following steps must be completed before using the symptom tables. 1. Perform the Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle , before using the symptom tables in order to verify that all of the following are true: - There are no DTCs set. - The control modules can communicate via the serial data links. 2. Review the system operation in order to familiarize yourself with the system functions. Refer to: - Data Link Communications Description and Operation - Body Control System Description and Operation Visual/Physical Inspection Inspect for aftermarket devices which could affect the operation of the systems. - Inspect the easily accessible or visible system components for obvious damage or conditions which could cause the symptom. Intermittent Faulty electrical connections or wiring may be the cause of intermittent conditions. Refer to Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Symptom List Refer to a symptom diagnostic procedure from the following list in order to diagnose the symptom: Scan Tool Does Not Power Up - Scan Tool Does Not Communicate with Class 2 Device (4.2L w/o Immobilizer) Scan Tool Does Not Communicate with Class 2 Device (4.2L w/Immobilizer) Scan Tool Does Not Communicate with Class 2 Device (5.3L) - Scan Tool Does Not Communicate with High Speed GMLAN Device Scan Tool Does Not Communicate with High Speed GMLAN Device SCAN TOOL DOES NOT COMMUNICATE WITH HIGH SPEED GMLAN DEVICE Modules connected to the high speed GMLAN serial data circuits monitor for serial data communications on the high speed GMLAN network during normal vehicle operation. Operating information and commands are exchanged among the modules. When a module detects a bus-off condition, a DTC U2100 will be set. This DTC can be retrieved as history only. DIAGNOSTIC AIDS The high speed GMLAN serial data bus uses two 120 ohm terminating resistors that are in parallel with the high speed GMLAN (+) and (-) circuits. One of the resistors is connected at the data link connector (DLC) and the other is at the engine control module (ECM). When testing for a short between high speed GMLAN (+) and (-), a reading of 60 ohms is normal. If the high speed GMLAN serial data is open, testing the resistance between high speed GMLAN (+) and (-) will read about 120 ohms. The engine will not start when there is a total malfunction of the high speed GMLAN serial data circuits while the engine is not running. The following conditions may cause a total loss of high speed GMLAN data communication: A short between high speed GMLAN (+) and high speed GMLAN (-) circuits - Any of the high speed GMLAN serial data circuits shorted to ground or voltage - A module internal malfunction that causes a short to voltage or ground on the high speed GMLAN circuits - Any of the high speed GMLAN serial data circuits open TEST DESCRIPTION Page 3458 Fuse Block - Underhood C1 (5.3L/6.0L) Page 7561 6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias. Reference the appropriate service manual wiring schematic to obtain the correct diode installation position. 7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for the soldering equipment. 8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed. 9. IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode attachment points with tape. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape. Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable SPLICING TWISTED OR SHIELDED CABLE Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable. 1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splice is made. 3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire. Staggering the splices by 65 mm (2.5 in) is recommended. 4. IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical contact with the drain wire. Re-assemble the cable. Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape. - Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1). - Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire. - Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape. Page 846 Depress the locks that are located on both sides of the wiredress cover and pull the lever over and past the locks. View of the connector when released from the component. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the front of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool push down on one of the locking tabs and pull the cover up until the dress cover releases. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. A/T - Key Will Not Release From Ignition Lock Cylinder Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Key Will Not Release From Ignition Lock Cylinder Bulletin No.: 05-07-30-021B Date: October 04, 2007 TECHNICAL Subject: Ignition Key Will Not Remove From Ignition Lock Cylinder (Reposition Shifter Boot) Models: 2004-2007 Buick Rainier 2002-2008 Chevrolet TrailBlazer Models 2002-2008 GMC Envoy Models 2003-2004 Oldsmobile Bravada Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to include the 2008 model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 05-07-30-021A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle). Condition Some customers may comment that they are unable to remove the ignition key from the ignition cylinder. Cause The shifter boot may be caught/trapped in the shifter assembly mechanism. Correction Inspect the shifter boot for being caught/trapped in the shifter assembly. If the shifter boot is NOT caught/trapped in the shift assembly, refer to Ignition Key Cannot Be Removed from the Ignition Lock Cylinder in SI. If the shifter boot IS caught/trapped in the shifter assembly, continue with the next step. DO NOT replace the complete shifter assembly for this condition. ONLY replace the shifter boot/handle if damaged by shifter assembly. Reposition the shifter boot so that it is not caught/trapped in the shifter assembly. Warranty Information Service and Repair Rear Engine Plate: Service and Repair Engine Rear Cover Replacement Tools Required J 41476 Front and Rear Cover Alignment Tool at crankshaft seal area Removal Procedure 1. Remove the engine flywheel. Refer to Engine Flywheel Replacement. 2. Remove the oil pan-to-rear cover bolts (1). 3. Remove the rear cover bolts. 4. Remove the rear cover and gasket. 5. Discard the rear cover gasket. 6. Clean and inspect the rear cover. Refer to Crankshaft Rear Oil Seal Housing Cleaning and Inspection. Installation Procedure Page 4703 7. Wrap electrical tape around the connection as shown. 8. Route the engine coolant heater cord and extension cord behind the alternator and adjacent to the engine coolant crossover pipe as shown. 9. Continue to route the extension cord to the exit location desired by the customer as shown. 10. Review the routing of the coolant heater cord and extension cord to verify that it does not touch any sharp edges that could damage it. 11. Secure the engine coolant heater cord and the extension cord with tie straps as needed. 12. Resecure any of the original clips that retained the engine coolant heater cord to the vehicle that were released to provide length. Part Information The extension cord may be obtained at any of the following outlets: - Lowes* - Home Depot* - Canada: Acklands-Grainger* (www.acklandsgrainger.com), Catalogue Part Number: CWRSJTOW3C14-10 USA: Cords should bear the UL symbol. Canada: Cords should bear the ULc symbol or CSA approval. *We believe these sources and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume any responsibility for the products or material from these firms or for any such items that may be available from other sources. Campaign - Possible Fuel Sender Port Fracture Fuel Gauge Sender: Recalls Campaign - Possible Fuel Sender Port Fracture Subject: Service Update for Inventory and Customer Vehicles-Fuel Sending Unit Port Fracture-Extended Start/Sluggish Acceleration/Check Engine Light-Expires with Base Warranty # 07005 - (02/16/2007) Models: 2007 Buick Rainier 2007 Chevrolet TrailBlazer 2007 GMC Envoy 2007 Saab 9-7X THIS SERVICE UPDATE INCLUDES VEHICLES IN DEALER INVENTORY AND CUSTOMER VEHICLES THAT RETURN FOR ANY TYPE OF SERVICE, AND WILL EXPIRE AT THE END OF THE INVOLVED VEHICLE'S NEW VEHICLE LIMITED WARRANTY PERIOD. Purpose This bulletin provides a service procedure to determine if a fuel tank sending unit requires replacement on certain 2007 Buick Rainier, Chevrolet Trailblazer, GMC Envoy, and Saab 9-7X vehicles. The fuel tank sending unit on these vehicles may have a fractured internal port. A fractured port will not deliver fuel to the engine at the designed pressure. If this were to occur, it could result in an extended start, sluggish acceleration, and/or the illumination of the check engine light. This service procedure should be completed as soon as possible on involved vehicles currently in dealer inventory and customer vehicles that return to the dealer/retailer for any type of service during the New Vehicle Limited Warranty coverage period. Vehicles Involved A list of involved vehicles currently in dealer inventory is attached to the Administrative Message (GM US), Dealer Communication (Canada), or IRIS (Saab U.S.), used to release this bulletin. Customer vehicles that return for service, for any reason, and are still covered under the vehicle's base warranty, and are within the VIN breakpoints shown, should be checked for vehicle eligibility in the appropriate system listed below. Important: Dealers are to confirm vehicle eligibility prior to beginning repairs by using the system(s) below. Not all vehicles within the above breakpoints may be involved. -- GM dealers and Canadian Saab retailers should use GMVIS. -- US Saab dealers should use IRIS On-Line Recall/Campaign Inquiry. Parts Information - GM and Saab Canada Only Parts required to complete this service update are to be obtained from General Motors Service Parts Operations (GMSPO). Please refer to your "involved vehicles listing" before ordering parts. Normal orders should be placed on a DRO = Daily Replenishment Order. In an emergency situation, parts should be ordered on a CSO = Customer Special Order. Parts Information - Saab US Only Page 9038 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert terminal into the appropriate terminal holder until it hits bottom and stops. The correct terminal holder is determined by the wire size. Also ensure that the terminals wings are pointing towards the former on the tool and the release locator. 5. Insert the stripped cable into the terminal. Insulation should be visible on both sides of the terminal insulation wings. 6. Compress the handles until the ratchet automatically releases. 7. Place the terminal into the appropriate cavity and assemble the connector. Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO-PACK 100W) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W connectors. These connectors are very similar but use different terminals and have some minor physical differences also. Page 7398 View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. View of the release tool being used for the smaller terminals. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (2-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 874 3. Remove the dress cover by using a flat-blade tool to release the connector locking tabs and pulling off the dress cover. 4. Relieve the tension on the nose piece retainers by inserting J-38125-12A (12094429) into the single retainer slot on the end of the nose piece and gently prying out the locking tab. Repeat the process for both of the nose piece locking tabs on the opposite side of the nose piece. Page 8990 4. Position the tool J 41364-A onto the park/neutral position switch. Ensure that the 2 slots on the switch where the manual shaft is inserted are lined up with the lower 2 tabs on the tool. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 5. Rotate the tool until the upper locator pin on the tool is lined up with the slot on the top of the switch. Tighten the bolts securing the switch to 25 N.m (18 lb ft). 6. Remove the J 41364-A from the switch. If installing a new switch, remove the positive assurance bracket at this time. 7. Connect the electrical connectors to the switch. 8. Install the transmission control lever to the manual shaft with the nut. Tighten the control lever nut to 25 N.m (18 lb ft). 9. Lower the vehicle. 10. Check the switch for proper operation. The engine must start in the P (Park) or N (Neutral) positions only. If proper operation of the switch can not be obtained, replace the switch. Page 6255 2. Use a small flat-bladed tool to release the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting the tool in the small recess on the side of the connector and pushing up until the TPA releases from the connector body. The TPA should raise just slightly. Do not try to remove the TPA. IMPORTANT: The TPA on this connector cannot be removed unless the terminals are removed first. The TPA will come out of the connector body, but only slightly. When the TPA is slightly raised the terminals can be removed. Using excessive force to remove the TPA with the terminals still in the connector will damage the connector. 3. Repeat the process for the other side of the connector. 4. Ensure that the TPA is in the proper position to remove the terminals. Page 381 - JST connectors have JST in small letters on their connectors, similar to that above. The location of the logo will vary with the connector size and style. - Kostel has an "LK" with a circle around it. These connector are usually used as a transmissions connection and are currently use on some Cadillac vehicles. Page 2353 Release the lower wiredress cover locking tab. Release the upper wiredress cover locking tab. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. Page 2221 11. Insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) into the 2 triangular cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 12. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE 1. Prior to installation the terminal must be aligned so the (1) coding lugs align with the (2) coding grooves on the connector. 2. Once the terminal is aligned, slide the terminal into the cavity until the retainer has engaged in the cavity of the connector. 3. Slide the TPA in the connector body and seat it using a small flat bladed tool. The TPA is seated when it is flush with the contact housing. 4. Secure the wires to the connector body using a tie wrap and replace the dress cover and grommet. Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) BOSCH CONNECTORS (2.8 JPT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Pull out the slider on the connector position assurance (CPA) until it is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 7785 2. Locate the nose piece locking tabs that are positioned on the side of the connector nose piece. The connector nose piece acts as a terminal positive assurance (TPA) and may be referred to as such. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to push in one of the locking tabs while gently pulling on the same side of the nose piece. 4. Repeat the procedure for the other locking tab and remove the nose piece. 5. Remove the wire dress cover. The following is a general procedure for wire dress cover removal. Use this procedure as a guide, some dress cover removal procedures may vary. 6. Use fingers to squeeze the 2 locking legs of the cover. Page 3344 Page 6317 5. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove TPA from the connector. 6. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Page 8954 7. Pressing the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool in the release cavity of the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and crimper in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (DOOR MODULE) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Side view of connector. View of top of connector. 1. Locate the assist lever and lock on the top of the connector. Page 5792 Page 1759 5. Once the nose piece retainers are relaxed, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should raise slightly. 6. On the opposite side of the nose piece, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should release completely. If the nose piece does not come off, repeat the procedure on the opposite side. Page 6078 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (BSK) BOSCH CONNECTORS (BSK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 3. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 4. Insert the J 38125-561 tool into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 5. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is Page 6153 6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias. Reference the appropriate service manual wiring schematic to obtain the correct diode installation position. 7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for the soldering equipment. 8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed. 9. IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode attachment points with tape. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape. Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable SPLICING TWISTED OR SHIELDED CABLE Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable. 1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splice is made. 3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire. Staggering the splices by 65 mm (2.5 in) is recommended. 4. IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical contact with the drain wire. Re-assemble the cable. Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape. - Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1). - Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire. - Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape. Page 610 Body Control Module: Diagrams Body Control Module (BCM) C3 Body Control Module (BCM) C3 Page 3383 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert terminal into the appropriate terminal holder until it hits bottom and stops. The correct terminal holder is determined by the wire size. Also ensure that the terminals wings are pointing towards the former on the tool and the release locator. 5. Insert the stripped cable into the terminal. Insulation should be visible on both sides of the terminal insulation wings. 6. Compress the handles until the ratchet automatically releases. 7. Place the terminal into the appropriate cavity and assemble the connector. Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO-PACK 100W) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W connectors. These connectors are very similar but use different terminals and have some minor physical differences also. Page 8796 11. Insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) into the 2 triangular cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 12. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE 1. Prior to installation the terminal must be aligned so the (1) coding lugs align with the (2) coding grooves on the connector. 2. Once the terminal is aligned, slide the terminal into the cavity until the retainer has engaged in the cavity of the connector. 3. Slide the TPA in the connector body and seat it using a small flat bladed tool. The TPA is seated when it is flush with the contact housing. 4. Secure the wires to the connector body using a tie wrap and replace the dress cover and grommet. Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) BOSCH CONNECTORS (2.8 JPT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Pull out the slider on the connector position assurance (CPA) until it is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 8917 - Most Molex connectors will have the Molex logo on the dresscover of the connector. In some cases the connectors may have MX followed by another letter. The third letter indicates where the connector was made. A connector with MXD is a Molex connector made in Detroit. Sumitomo has a unique symbol on their connector and possibly a part number. The symbol is similar to that of a diamond lying on its side, similar to that shown. The logo could appear anywhere but the most common place is at the wire side of the housing. Tyco/AMP has many different and unique connector designs. Some may or may not have identifiable marks on them. Page 7583 Step 10 - Step 13 The numbers below refer to the step numbers on the diagnostic table. 2. A partial malfunction in the high speed GMLAN serial data circuits uses a different procedure from a total malfunction of the high speed GMLAN data circuits. The following modules are connected to the high speed GMLAN serial data circuits: ECM, for 5.3L - Transmission control module (TCM) 5. Data link connector terminals 6 and 14 provide the connection to the GMLAN serial data high circuit and the GMLAN serial data low circuit respectively. 12. The communication malfunction may have prevented diagnosis of the customer complaint. Scan Tool Does Not Power Up SCAN TOOL DOES NOT POWER UP CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION The data link connector (DLC) is a standardized 16 cavity connector. Connector design and location is dictated by an industry wide standard, and is required to provide the following: Scan tool power battery positive voltage at terminal 16 - Scan tool power ground at terminal 4 - Common signal ground at terminal 5 The scan tool will power up with the ignition OFF. Some modules however, will not communicate unless the ignition is ON and the power mode master (PMM) module sends the appropriate power mode message. TEST DESCRIPTION Page 2504 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Start in the middle and gradually move the heat barrel to the open ends of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Heated Oxygen Sensor Wiring Repairs HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being obstructed. If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. - Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks, etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire. - Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance. - To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector. Page 8989 Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair Park/Neutral Position Switch Replacement Tools Required J 41364-A Park/Neutral Switch Aligner Removal Procedure 1. Apply the parking brake. 2. Shift the transmission into neutral. 3. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 4. Remove the nut securing the transmission control lever to the manual shaft. 5. Remove the transmission control lever from the manual shaft. 6. Disconnect the electrical connectors from the switch. 7. Remove the bolts securing the park/neutral position switch to the transmission. 8. Remove the park/neutral position switch from the manual shaft. If the park/neutral position switch did not slide off the manual shaft, file the outer edge of the manual shaft in order to remove any burrs. Installation Procedure 1. Install the switch to the transmission manual shaft by aligning the switch hub flats with the manual shaft flats. 2. Slide the switch onto the transmission manual shaft until the switch mounting bracket contacts the mounting bosses on the transmission. Important: If a new switch is being installed, the switch will come with a positive assurance bracket. The positive assurance bracket aligns the new switch in it proper position for installation and the use of neutral position adjustment tool will not be necessary. 3. Install the switch to the transmission with 2 bolts finger tight. Page 2105 5. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove TPA from the connector. 6. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Page 2669 Page 8021 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Ensure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the Terminal Removal Procedure. Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PULL TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL If the terminal is visibly damaged or is suspected of having a faulty connection, the terminal should be replaced. Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors: 1. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) device and/or the secondary lock. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component or separate the connectors for in-line connectors. 3. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device. 4. Insert the proper pick or removal tool into the front of the connector body. 5. IMPORTANT: On connectors with more than one terminal the service loop may not be large enough to remove the terminal and crimp on a new one. If the terminal wire does not have a large enough service loop for removal, cut the wire 5 cm (2 in) behind the connector before removal. Grasp the wire at the back of the connector body and gently push the terminal out the front of the connector body. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. If the wire needed to be cut in order to remove the terminal, gently push a small length of the same size wire through the back of the connector cavity until there is enough wire exposed in order to crimp on a new terminal. If the wire was not cut, cut the existing wire as close to the old terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 4. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. TERMINAL INSTALLATION 1. Align the terminal and pull the wire from the back of the connector in order to seat the terminal. 2. If necessary, cut the new wire to proper length and splice with existing circuit. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. 3. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply dielectric grease to the connector. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PUSH TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 2507 11. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 12. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 13. Center the high temperature SCT1 shrink tube over the DuraSeal splice sleeve. 14. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the high temperature heat shrink tubing. 15. Gradually move the heat from the center to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 16. Replace any reflective tape and clips that may have been remove during the repair. Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation REPAIRING DAMAGED WIRE INSULATION Wire Size Conversion Page 1441 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. 4. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front of the connector. Page 7165 difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Bosch Connectors (ECM) BOSCH CONNECTORS (ECM) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the assist lever on the top of the connector. Move the assist lever to the forward position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 1993 View of a typical Micro 64 connector. Depress the lock and pull the lever over and past the lock. Page 1839 Checking Aftermarket Accessories CHECKING AFTERMARKET ACCESSORIES Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits: - CAUTION: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol. - NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice. OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol. Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the cause of the problems. Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include: Power feeds connected to points other than the battery - Antenna location - Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring - Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line - Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories. Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions INDUCING INTERMITTENT FAULT CONDITIONS TOOLS REQUIRED J 25070 Heat Gun Many intermittent open or shorted circuits are affected by harness/connector movement that is caused by vibration, engine torque, bumps/rough pavement, etc. In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness if the malfunction appears to be Page 4410 REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. The release tab is located on the top of the wiredress cover. View of connector in released position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Page 3366 difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Bosch Connectors (ECM) BOSCH CONNECTORS (ECM) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the assist lever on the top of the connector. Move the assist lever to the forward position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 2514 6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias. Reference the appropriate service manual wiring schematic to obtain the correct diode installation position. 7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for the soldering equipment. 8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed. 9. IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode attachment points with tape. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape. Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable SPLICING TWISTED OR SHIELDED CABLE Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable. 1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splice is made. 3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire. Staggering the splices by 65 mm (2.5 in) is recommended. 4. IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical contact with the drain wire. Re-assemble the cable. Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape. - Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1). - Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire. - Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape. Page 5735 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert a small flat-blade tool in the slot below the front loaded terminal position assurance (TPA) and pry up. 3. Remove the TPA by pulling it out of the connector. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-553 (GM P/N 15315247) on a slight upward angle into the cavity below the terminal to be removed. Ensure that the pointed on the end of the tool is facing the bottom of the terminal and it stays in contact with the terminal until it stops on the plastic terminal retainer. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 5973 7. Apply pressure and gently rock the cover until one locking leg is unseated. 8. Continue to apply pressure and rock the cover until the second locking leg is unseated. Repeat procedure for the other side of the dress cover and remove the cover. 9. Use J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) to gently lift the terminal retaining tab while gently pulling the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 10. If the terminal is severely bent or damaged, it may be possible on some connectors to push the wire out of the front of the connector instead of Page 4138 1. Apply a 5 mm (0.2 in) bead of sealant 20 mm (0.8 in) long to the engine block. Refer to Sealers, Adhesives, and Lubricants for the correct part number. Apply the sealant directly onto the tabs of the front cover gasket that protrudes into the oil pan surface. 2. Apply a 5 mm (0.2 in) bead of sealant 20 mm (0.8 in) long to the engine block. Refer to Sealers, Adhesives, and Lubricants for the correct part number. Apply the sealant directly onto the tabs of the rear cover gasket that protrudes into the oil pan surface. 3. Pre-assemble the oil pan gasket and bolts to the pan. ^ Install the gasket onto the pan. ^ Install the oil pan bolts to the pan and through the gasket. 4. Install the oil pan, oil pan gasket, and bolts to the engine block as an assembly. 5. Hand thread the oil pan bolts into the engine block until snug. Do not tighten at this time. Page 7753 MEASURING FREQUENCY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal. IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM to autorange to an appropriate range. 1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency measured. Measuring Voltage MEASURING VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit. 1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods: - Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. - Turn ON the engine. - Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls. - Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested. 3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The DMM displays the voltage measured at that point. Measuring Voltage Drop MEASURING VOLTAGE DROP NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points. Probing Electrical Connectors PROBING ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS Page 6553 View of the connector when released from the component. View of another type of Micro 64 connector. Page 5368 Open the harness by removing any tape. 2. Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. 3. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 4. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent american wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 5. Slide a section of high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing down the length of wire to be spliced. Ensure that the shrink tubing will not interfere with the splice procedure. 6. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 7. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. 8. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 9. Insert the wire into the DuraSeal splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 10. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Locations Power Seat Motor Position Sensor: Locations Under Driver Seat Page 8856 The engine harness may be repaired using the J-38125. High Temperature Wiring Repairs HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperatures, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time may use materials i.e. wires, connectors, and shielding that has a higher heat rating than typical wiring. When making a repair in a high temperature area observe the following: Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature to replace any damaged wire. - Replace any heat shielding that is removed. - Cover any DuraSeal splice sleeves with SCT1 shrink tubing (available in the J-38125 Terminal Repair kit). - After making a wiring repair, ensure that the location of the wiring is not moved closer to the heat source. IDENTIFYING HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperature, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time need special considerations when making wiring repairs. Areas that may be exposed to higher temperatures can be identified by heat resistant materials that are being used in those areas. These materials may include heat reflective tape, moon tape, and high temperature shrink tubing. Also conduit and other protective coverings may be used. Because conduit or similar coverings are used throughout the vehicle regardless of the temperature, it may be necessary for the technician to determine if an area is exposed to excessive heat before making a wiring repair. Obvious areas of consideration would be any area located near the exhaust manifolds, catalytic converter, and exhaust pipes. The J-38125 contains much of the material you will need to perform repairs on areas exposed to high heat. The kit contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves to crimp and seal connections - High temperature SCT1 shrink tubing to protect the splice sleeves - A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct crimp tool to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools to remove the terminals from the connectors The J-38125 does not contain wire that is suitable to high temperature exposure. Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature of the same or larger gage size as the original wire when repair damage wire. Also replace any reflective tape that you remove during the repair. HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature rating of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125 and then encapsulate the splice sleeve using the high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the order listed. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip keeping all of the wire strands intact. Page 3057 15. Extract the power steering gear oil seal (1) from the power steering gear using the J 44586 (2) with the aid of a flat-bladed tool (3) for additional leverage. Installation Procedure 1. Install the NEW power steering gear oil seal (1) to the power steering gear using the seal installation end of the J 44586 (2). 2. Ensure the power steering gear oil seals (1) are fully seated in the power steering gear. 3. Lower the vehicle. Page 7847 Page 1901 3. Use a small flat-bladed tool to gently pry off the dress cover by inserting the tool under the cover opposite the harness side and prying up. 4. Remove the cover. 5. Using a small flat-bladed tool, push on the side of the nose piece retainer while pushing the nose piece forward with your thumb. This will release the terminal position assurance (TPA). 6. Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) into the corresponding terminal release cavity. The release cavities are the 2 center rows of cavities on one half of the connector. Capacity Specifications Fluid - A/T: Capacity Specifications Fluid Capacity Specifications Pan Removal ....................................................................................................................................... ........................................................ 4.7 liters (5.0 qts) Overhaul .............................................................................................................................................. .................................................. 10.6 liters (11.0 qts) Dry Fill W/ 280 mm Torque Converter.................................................................................................. ............................................. 11.25 Liters (11.9 qts) Dry Fill W/ 300 mm Torque Converter.................................................................................................. ............................................... 11.5 Liters (12.1 qts) Measurements are approximate Page 5456 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. JST Connectors JST CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, remove the connector from the component. Page 4484 Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested: - Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. - Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a component or to other harnesses. - If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A TEST LAMP TOOLS REQUIRED J 35616-200 Test Light - Probe Kit NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminate even though voltage is present. The J 35616-200 is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair of leads. To properly operate this tool use the following procedures. When testing for voltage: 1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested. When testing for ground: 1. Attach one lead to battery positive voltage. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where ground should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is ground at the point being tested. Using Connector Test Adapters USING CONNECTOR TEST ADAPTERS NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Using Fused Jumper Wires USING FUSED JUMPER WIRES TOOLS REQUIRED J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged. The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested. AFL/ECP Connectors AFL/EPC CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 4365 Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Page 8697 2. Locate the two indents of the terminal position assurance (TPA) located on the bottom of the connector body. Diagram Information and Instructions Throttle Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions Electrical Symbols Page 7992 - A control module from another vehicle is installed. - Revised software/calibration files have been released for this vehicle. - IMPORTANT: DO NOT re-program the control module with the SAME software/calibration files that are already present in the control module. This is not an effective repair for any type of concern. Verify that the control module contains the correct software/calibration. If incorrect programming is found, reprogram the control module with the most current software/calibration. Refer to Control Module References for replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Testing for Short to Ground TESTING FOR SHORT TO GROUND NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 4. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit. With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is a short to ground in the circuit. Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2. Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). - When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. - If the DMM does not display voltage 4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is shorted. Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A DIGITAL MULTIMETER NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the powertrain control module (PCM), should only be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200 Digital Multimeter (DMM). The J 39200 instruction manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminage even though voltage is present. The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity. IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading. Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the measurement. Page 6048 1. If reinstalling the old sensor, coat the threads with anti-seize compound GM P/N 12377953, or equivalent. Notice: Refer to Component Fastener Tightening Notice. 2. Install the HO2S (2). Tighten the sensor to 42 N.m (31 lb ft). 3. Connect the HO2S electrical connector (1). 4. Install the CPA retainer. 5. Lower the vehicle. Page 7208 3. Remove the dress cover by using a flat-blade tool to release the connector locking tabs and pulling off the dress cover. 4. Relieve the tension on the nose piece retainers by inserting J-38125-12A (12094429) into the single retainer slot on the end of the nose piece and gently prying out the locking tab. Repeat the process for both of the nose piece locking tabs on the opposite side of the nose piece. Locations Driver Door Module (DDM) Page 8050 6. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by pressing on the tang. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (SENSOR) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) tool into the cavity on the lower right hand face of the connector until the terminal release tang access panel slides over. Page 4379 Release the tabs that are holding the wiredress cover to the connector body. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the slots on both ends of the connector body. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. J 38125-216 can also be used to remove the nose piece. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by lifting the terminal retaining tabs on the inside of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 9023 5. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove TPA from the connector. 6. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Page 232 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry one side of the nose piece up to the pre-stage position. When the nose piece is in the pre-staged position, the nose piece will be raised above the connector body the length of the step in the nose piece. 7. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry the other side of the piece to the pre-stage position. If the nose piece is higher than the first step in the nose piece, gently push down on the nose piece until it meets with resistance from the connector body, you should feel the nose piece click into position. Page 7523 4. Slide the dress cover forward and off of the connector. 5. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front and rear of the connector. Page 6007 5. While pushing the terminal forward, insert the J 38125-24 in the release cavity above the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (43-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Page 3774 3. Remove the dress cover by using a flat-blade tool to release the connector locking tabs and pulling off the dress cover. 4. Relieve the tension on the nose piece retainers by inserting J-38125-12A (12094429) into the single retainer slot on the end of the nose piece and gently prying out the locking tab. Repeat the process for both of the nose piece locking tabs on the opposite side of the nose piece. Page 5936 Page 5547 - Kostel - Molex - Sumitomo - Tyco/AMP - Yazaki Identifying the manufacturer of a connector is often difficult. When trying to determine the manufacturer of a connector, look for specific identifying marks that are unique to that connector supplier. Most of these identify marks are hard to find or see. Check the connector carefully and refer to the information below for pictures and descriptions of connector identification markings. - Most of AFLs connectors have EPC on their connector body. Some of the smaller connectors will not have any markings on them. - In some cases Bosch will actually be printed on the connector. If Bosch does not appear on the connector, look for the Bosch logo. The Bosch logo is a circle with a blunted arrow inside. This logo can appear anywhere on the connector and is often very small. Page 4853 breakers are used. CIRCUIT BREAKER This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high current is removed. POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) CIRCUIT BREAKER This type greatly increases its resistance when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker will re-close within a second or 2. Circuit Protection - Fuses CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSES The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and examine the element in the fuse for an open (2). If not broken (1), also check for continuity using a DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one of equal current rating. Circuit Protection - Fusible Links CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSIBLE LINKS Diagram Information and Instructions Engine Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions Electrical Symbols Diagrams Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Diagrams Engine Controls Connector End Views Mass Air Flow (MAF)/Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor Page 4475 Checking Aftermarket Accessories CHECKING AFTERMARKET ACCESSORIES Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits: - CAUTION: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol. - NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice. OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol. Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the cause of the problems. Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include: Power feeds connected to points other than the battery - Antenna location - Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring - Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line - Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories. Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions INDUCING INTERMITTENT FAULT CONDITIONS TOOLS REQUIRED J 25070 Heat Gun Many intermittent open or shorted circuits are affected by harness/connector movement that is caused by vibration, engine torque, bumps/rough pavement, etc. In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness if the malfunction appears to be Page 7052 Release the lower wiredress cover locking tab. Release the upper wiredress cover locking tab. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. Page 4382 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. 4. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front of the connector. Page 4766 Page 6882 - A control module from another vehicle is installed. - Revised software/calibration files have been released for this vehicle. - IMPORTANT: DO NOT re-program the control module with the SAME software/calibration files that are already present in the control module. This is not an effective repair for any type of concern. Verify that the control module contains the correct software/calibration. If incorrect programming is found, reprogram the control module with the most current software/calibration. Refer to Control Module References for replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Testing for Short to Ground TESTING FOR SHORT TO GROUND NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 4. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit. With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is a short to ground in the circuit. Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2. Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). - When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. - If the DMM does not display voltage 4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is shorted. Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A DIGITAL MULTIMETER NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the powertrain control module (PCM), should only be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200 Digital Multimeter (DMM). The J 39200 instruction manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminage even though voltage is present. The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity. IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading. Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the measurement. Page 6244 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 7199 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Kostal Connectors KOSTAL CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 4326 7. Remove the coolant air bleed pipe cover bolts (312), if necessary. 8. Remove the coolant air bleed covers (313) with seals (308), if necessary. 9. Remove and discard the seals (308) from the coolant air bleed pipe and covers. Installation Procedure Page 1895 8. Insert the J 38125-213 into the small terminal release hole on the nose piece and gently pull on the back of the wire. 9. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Repairing Connector Terminals REPAIRING CONNECTOR TERMINALS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following: Push to Seat terminals - Pull to Seat terminals Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your terminal repair. The J-38125 contains further information. 1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.For cable seal terminals, remove the seal. 2. Apply the correct cable seal per gage size of the wire, if used.Slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation removal. 3. Remove the insulation. 4. For sealed terminals only, align the seal with the end of the cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal.For sealed terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal. 6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.For sealed terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable. 8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals excepting Micro-Pack 100.64 size. Soldering Micro-Pack 100 World terminals may damage the terminal. Sumitomo Connectors SUMITOMO CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 3747 4. Once the front 2 locks are unlocked, lift the front of the dress cover and pull it forward. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the small slot on the TPA and pushing down until the TPA releases. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to angle or rock the J 38125-21 tool when inserting it into the connector or the tool may break. Insert the J 38125-21 (GM P/N 15381651-2) tool into the round canal between the terminals cavities at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to repair Micro 64 connector terminals. The Micro 64 connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-64 (M jaw) was developed to crimp Micro 64 terminals. The J 38125-64 crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. The J 38125-64 crimping tool is also designed to crimp both the wire and the insulation at the same time. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro 64 terminals. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. 1. Cut the wire as close to the damaged terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. Page 7526 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. 4. Remove the dress cover by using a flat bladed tool to release the dress cover locking tabs and lift up on the dress cover. 5. Cut the tie wrap that holds the wires to the connector body. Page 2334 Connector Anatomy Connector Repairs contains a list of all connector repairs. The connector repairs are listed by the connector manufacturer and then by connector type. If the technician cannot identify the manufacturer of the connector, refer to Identifying Connectors below. Knowing the connector manufacturer will assist in finding the correct connector repair from the following list: - Connector Position Assurance Locks - Terminal Position Assurance Locks - Bosch Connectors (0.64) Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) Bosch Connectors (BSK) Bosch Connectors (ECM) - Delphi Connectors (Micro.64) Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) Delphi Connectors (12-Way) - Tyco/AMP Connectors (CM 42-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) Tyco/AMP Connectors (025 Cap) Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) - Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) - Repairing Connector Terminals IDENTIFYING CONNECTORS Knowing the connector manufacturer is helpful when trying to locating the correct connector repair procedure. There are many different connector designs used on GM vehicles and it is sometimes difficult to identify the connector manufacturer. The information in this document should help with the identification of connector manufactures. The following connector manufacturers make most of the connectors found in GM vehicles: AFL/EPC (Alcoa Fujikura Ltd./Engineered Plastics Components) - Bosch - Delphi - FCI (Framatome Connectors International) - JAE (Japan Aviation Electronics) - JST (Japan Solderless Terminals) Page 8024 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) and slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. Page 5184 The first connector design of the Micro-Pack 100W (1) has a white connector interface that holds the terminals. The second design of the Micro-Pack 100W (2) has a gray interface to hold the terminals. Also, the first design has terminal cavities that are further apart (3 mm centerline) and offset from the other row of terminal cavities in the connector. The second design has terminals cavities that are closer together (2.54 mm centerline) and aligned vertically. One other way to identify the second design is the thin strip of material that runs along the outside of the cavities. IMPORTANT: There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W terminals which are very similar. Ensure that you have the correct terminal before crimping the new terminal to the wire. The first design connector uses the longer terminal (1) that has a raised area in front of the recess in the terminal. The second design connector uses the shorter terminal without the raised area. Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro-Pack 100W connectors. Some Micro-Pack 100W connector disassembly procedures will vary. Use this procedure as a guide. 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 1440 difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Bosch Connectors (ECM) BOSCH CONNECTORS (ECM) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the assist lever on the top of the connector. Move the assist lever to the forward position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 8105 Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Install the 3 APP sensor bolts (1). Tighten the bolts to 20 N.m (15 lb ft). 3. Connect the APP sensor electrical connector. 4. Verify that the vehicle meets the following conditions: * The vehicle is not in a reduced engine power mode. * The ignition is ON. * The engine is OFF. 5. Connect a scan tool in order to test for a proper throttle-opening and throttle-closing range. 6. Operate the accelerator pedal and monitor the throttle angles. The accelerator pedal should operate freely, without binding, between a closed throttle, and a wide open throttle. Page 5615 US English/Metric Conversion US English/Metric Conversion Page 5346 5. Once the nose piece retainers are relaxed, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should raise slightly. 6. On the opposite side of the nose piece, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should release completely. If the nose piece does not come off, repeat the procedure on the opposite side. Page 8734 If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the DuraSeal splice sleeves. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: - Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. - Do not use the crimp and DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 to crimp DuraSeal splice sleeve. In order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. OnStar(R) - Incorrect GPS Position Reported During Call Emergency Contact Module: Customer Interest OnStar(R) - Incorrect GPS Position Reported During Call Bulletin No.: 02-08-46-006C Date: January 08, 2008 INFORMATION Subject: Incorrect OnStar(R) Global Positioning System (GPS) Location Reported During OnStar(R) Call Models: 2000-2008 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2003-2008 HUMMER H2 2006-2008 HUMMER H3 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X with OnStar(R) Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 02-08-46-006B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories). A small number of the above-mentioned vehicles may exhibit a condition in which the vehicle reports an inaccurate location to the OnStar(R) Call Center. This condition can only be identified via a button press to the OnStar(R) Call Center by the customer. Call Center personnel will be able to identify this inaccurate location condition. Customers will then be notified through the mail by OnStar(R) if their vehicle exhibits this condition. Once this condition has been identified OnStar(R) will instruct the customer to return to the dealership to have this condition corrected. It is not necessary to reconfigure the vehicle after the following procedure. In order to correct this condition you must cycle power to the OnStar(R) system. This can be done by either removing the fuses powering the OnStar(R) system or disconnecting the OnStar(R) module (VCIM) from the vehicle. As a last resort you can disconnect the vehicle's battery. The power needs to be removed from the system for approximately 15 minutes. After completing this procedure the vehicle should be taken to an area with an unobstructed view of the sky. The vehicle should be kept running for approximately 10 minutes to allow the vehicle to reacquire the global positioning system (GPS). Then contact the OnStar(R) Call Center via the blue OnStar(R) button and ask the advisor to verify the GPS position. If the OnStar(R) advisor still has an inaccurate GPS location refer to the Navigation Systems and Cellular Communications sub-sections in the Service Manual in order to diagnose and repair the concern. If the normal diagnostics lead to module replacement you will need to contact Technical Assistance (TAC) and choose the OnStar(R) prompt. GM OnStar(R) TAC will assist in the diagnosis and if appropriate order a replacement part. Replacement parts are usually shipped out within 24 hours and a pre-paid return package label will be included for returning the faulty part. By returning the faulty part you will avoid a significant non-return core charge. Warranty Information (excluding Saab US Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Warranty Information (Saab US Models) Page 7642 TERMINAL REMOVAL Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors. 1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA) device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1). 3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 4. Gently pull the cable and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector. 5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal, refer to Terminal Repair. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3. Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector. REINSTALLING TERMINAL 1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly, refer to Wiring Repairs. 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3. Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) DELPHI CONNECTORS (WEATHER PACK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Technician Safety Information Page 5768 4. Remove the fuel sender assembly (2) and seal (3). Discard the seal. Caution: Refer to Fuel Storage Caution. 5. Clean the fuel sender sealing surfaces (4). Important: Some lock ring were manufactured with DO NOT REUSE stamped into them. These lock rings may be reused if they are not damaged or warped. Important: Inspect the lock ring for damage due to improper removal or installation procedures. If damage is found, install a NEW lock ring. Important: Check the lock ring for flatness. 6. Place the lock ring on a flat surface. Measure the clearance between to lock ring and the flat surface using a feeler gage at 7 points. 7. If the warpage is less than 0.41 mm (0.016 in), the lock ring does not require replacement. 8. If the warpage is greater than 0.41 mm (0.016 in), the lock ring must be replaced. Installation Procedure Page 5827 View of a typical Micro 64 connector. Depress the lock and pull the lever over and past the lock. Page 8466 US English/Metric Conversion US English/Metric Conversion Page 805 Page 7754 IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals. Front probe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the connector. IMPORTANT: When probing female 0.64 terminals, it is important to use the correct adapter. There have been some revisions to the test adapter for 0.64 terminals. The proper adapter for 0.64 terminals is the J 35616-64B which has a gold terminal and a black wire between the base and tip. Failure to use the proper test adapter may result in damage to the terminal being tested and improper diagnosis. NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Page 5740 Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size. REPAIRING A FUSIBLE LINK IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient overload protection. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. Flat Wire Repairs FLAT WIRE REPAIRS NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced. GMLAN Wiring Repairs GMLAN WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The GM Local Area Network (GMLAN) System requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working on GMLAN connectors and terminals. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items in order to repair the GMLAN wiring: Dura Seal splice sleeves - A wire stripping tool - J 38125-8 Crimping Tool (GM P/N 12085115) - J 38125-5 Ultra Torch Special Tool (GM P/N 12085116) The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. - A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors GMLAN REPAIRS IMPORTANT: When making a repair to any GMLAN network, the original wire length after the repair must be the same length as before the repair. If the network is a twisted pair, the twist must be maintained after the repair is completed. GMLAN has 2 types of networks, low speed and high speed. Low speed GMLAN has a single wire and works at slow speeds. High speed GMLAN has 2 wires in a twisted pair and works at higher speeds. For more information on GMLAN, refer to Data Link Communications Description and Operation. GMLAN CONNECTOR TERMINAL REPAIR IMPORTANT: A service terminal can be used to replace damaged connector terminals for both high speed and low speed GMLAN systems. When making a connector terminal repair on a GMLAN high speed system with twisted pair wires, do not untwist the wires more than necessary to make the repair. The terminals in the GMLAN system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are available in the J-38125. If the individual terminals are damaged on any GMLAN connection, use the appropriate connector repair procedure in order to repair the terminal. GMLAN WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 2513 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches, and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original. - The wires insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the possibility of fuel contact. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1). 5. Select the proper duraseal splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool. Refer to the Crimp and Seal Splice Table. 6. Place the duraseal splice sleeve in the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115) crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 7. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to hold the duraseal splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 8. Insert the wires into the duraseal splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel in order to prevent the wire from passing through the splice (3). 9. Close the handles of the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115), until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is applied to the splice sleeve. 10. Shrink the insulation around the splice. - Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. - Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Splicing Inline Harness Diodes SPLICING INLINE HARNESS DIODES Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure. 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode. 2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool. 5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode. Page 8971 The engine harness may be repaired using the J-38125. High Temperature Wiring Repairs HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperatures, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time may use materials i.e. wires, connectors, and shielding that has a higher heat rating than typical wiring. When making a repair in a high temperature area observe the following: Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature to replace any damaged wire. - Replace any heat shielding that is removed. - Cover any DuraSeal splice sleeves with SCT1 shrink tubing (available in the J-38125 Terminal Repair kit). - After making a wiring repair, ensure that the location of the wiring is not moved closer to the heat source. IDENTIFYING HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperature, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time need special considerations when making wiring repairs. Areas that may be exposed to higher temperatures can be identified by heat resistant materials that are being used in those areas. These materials may include heat reflective tape, moon tape, and high temperature shrink tubing. Also conduit and other protective coverings may be used. Because conduit or similar coverings are used throughout the vehicle regardless of the temperature, it may be necessary for the technician to determine if an area is exposed to excessive heat before making a wiring repair. Obvious areas of consideration would be any area located near the exhaust manifolds, catalytic converter, and exhaust pipes. The J-38125 contains much of the material you will need to perform repairs on areas exposed to high heat. The kit contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves to crimp and seal connections - High temperature SCT1 shrink tubing to protect the splice sleeves - A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct crimp tool to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools to remove the terminals from the connectors The J-38125 does not contain wire that is suitable to high temperature exposure. Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature of the same or larger gage size as the original wire when repair damage wire. Also replace any reflective tape that you remove during the repair. HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature rating of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125 and then encapsulate the splice sleeve using the high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the order listed. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip keeping all of the wire strands intact. Page 7796 4. Use a small flat-blade tool to slide the terminal position assurance (TPA) up one notch on both ends of the connector. The TPA is located underneath the wire dress cover. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 3246 View of connector in released position. 4. Disconnect the connector from the component. 5. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Release the rear lower half of the wiredress cover. Page 577 Control Module HVAC: Diagrams HVAC - Automatic HVAC Connector End Views Blower Motor Control Module Page 6748 US English/Metric Conversion US English/Metric Conversion Page 4782 to analyze the data during the time a vehicle condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a trigger point that you have determined. Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2 snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a first-in, first-out basis. If a third snapshot is taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost. Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types: Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice - Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200 frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not lost if the Scan Tool is powered down. The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis. The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected values by plotting 3 parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful, especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC. Testing for a Short to Voltage TESTING FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4. Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt, there is a short to voltage in the circuit. Testing for Continuity TESTING FOR CONTINUITY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6. Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit. 7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity. With a Test Lamp IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits. 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6. If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity. Testing for Electrical Intermittents TESTING FOR ELECTRICAL INTERMITTENTS Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment. - Testing for Short to Ground - Testing for Continuity - Testing for a Short to Voltage Page 8307 View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. View of the release tool being used for the smaller terminals. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (2-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 7660 8. Insert the J 38125-213 into the small terminal release hole on the nose piece and gently pull on the back of the wire. 9. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Repairing Connector Terminals REPAIRING CONNECTOR TERMINALS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following: Push to Seat terminals - Pull to Seat terminals Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your terminal repair. The J-38125 contains further information. 1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.For cable seal terminals, remove the seal. 2. Apply the correct cable seal per gage size of the wire, if used.Slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation removal. 3. Remove the insulation. 4. For sealed terminals only, align the seal with the end of the cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal.For sealed terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal. 6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.For sealed terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable. 8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals excepting Micro-Pack 100.64 size. Soldering Micro-Pack 100 World terminals may damage the terminal. Sumitomo Connectors SUMITOMO CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 5966 View of a typical Micro 64 connector. Depress the lock and pull the lever over and past the lock. Page 7844 Page 8911 11. Insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) into the 2 triangular cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 12. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE 1. Prior to installation the terminal must be aligned so the (1) coding lugs align with the (2) coding grooves on the connector. 2. Once the terminal is aligned, slide the terminal into the cavity until the retainer has engaged in the cavity of the connector. 3. Slide the TPA in the connector body and seat it using a small flat bladed tool. The TPA is seated when it is flush with the contact housing. 4. Secure the wires to the connector body using a tie wrap and replace the dress cover and grommet. Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) BOSCH CONNECTORS (2.8 JPT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Pull out the slider on the connector position assurance (CPA) until it is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 2216 difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Bosch Connectors (ECM) BOSCH CONNECTORS (ECM) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the assist lever on the top of the connector. Move the assist lever to the forward position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 8014 Depress the locks that are located on both sides of the wiredress cover and pull the lever over and past the locks. View of the connector when released from the component. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the front of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool push down on one of the locking tabs and pull the cover up until the dress cover releases. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. Page 6250 7. Pressing the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool in the release cavity of the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and crimper in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (DOOR MODULE) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Side view of connector. View of top of connector. 1. Locate the assist lever and lock on the top of the connector. Page 3928 Engine Block Heater: Service and Repair Coolant Heater Cord Replacement Coolant Heater Cord Replacement Removal Procedure 1. If equipped with a 4.2L engine, remove the powertrain control module (PCM). Refer to Powertrain Control Module Replacement. 2. Remove the coolant heater cord from the engine harness bracket (1). 3. Remove the coolant heater cord from the coolant heater (2). 4. If equipped with a 5.3L or 6.0L engine, disconnect the coolant heater cord from the coolant heater (1). 5. Remove the coolant heater cord clip from the engine harness. 6. Disconnect the coolant heater cord retainers (1) from the battery cover. Installation Procedure Locations Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Locations Engine Controls Component Views Upper Right Side of the Engine - Front 1 - Engine 2 - Engine Harness 3 - Air Duct 4 - Mass Air Flow (MAF)/Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor Page 5745 11. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 12. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 13. Center the high temperature SCT1 shrink tube over the DuraSeal splice sleeve. 14. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the high temperature heat shrink tubing. 15. Gradually move the heat from the center to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 16. Replace any reflective tape and clips that may have been remove during the repair. Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation REPAIRING DAMAGED WIRE INSULATION Wire Size Conversion Page 7530 3. Remove the dress cover by using a flat-blade tool to release the connector locking tabs and pulling off the dress cover. 4. Relieve the tension on the nose piece retainers by inserting J-38125-12A (12094429) into the single retainer slot on the end of the nose piece and gently prying out the locking tab. Repeat the process for both of the nose piece locking tabs on the opposite side of the nose piece. Page 6239 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the rear TPA from the connector. 7. IMPORTANT: The front TPA cannot be removed from the connector. Only move it to the release point. Use a small flat-blade tool to move the front TPA to the release position. 8. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 9. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Molex Connectors Page 2804 Window Switch - RR Page 4653 2. Use a small flat-bladed tool to release the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting the tool in the small recess on the side of the connector and pushing up until the TPA releases from the connector body. The TPA should raise just slightly. Do not try to remove the TPA. IMPORTANT: The TPA on this connector cannot be removed unless the terminals are removed first. The TPA will come out of the connector body, but only slightly. When the TPA is slightly raised the terminals can be removed. Using excessive force to remove the TPA with the terminals still in the connector will damage the connector. 3. Repeat the process for the other side of the connector. 4. Ensure that the TPA is in the proper position to remove the terminals. Page 4079 6. Lower the vehicle. 7. Fill the crankcase with the proper quantity and grade of engine oil. Refer to Approximate Fluid Capacities and to Fluid and Lubricant Recommendations. 8. Remove the oil level indicator. 9. Wipe the indicator with a clean cloth. 10. Install the oil level indicator. 11. Remove the oil level indicator in order to check the level. 12. Add oil if necessary. 13. Close the hood. Page 1709 Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested: - Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. - Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a component or to other harnesses. - If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A TEST LAMP TOOLS REQUIRED J 35616-200 Test Light - Probe Kit NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminate even though voltage is present. The J 35616-200 is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair of leads. To properly operate this tool use the following procedures. When testing for voltage: 1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested. When testing for ground: 1. Attach one lead to battery positive voltage. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where ground should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is ground at the point being tested. Using Connector Test Adapters USING CONNECTOR TEST ADAPTERS NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Using Fused Jumper Wires USING FUSED JUMPER WIRES TOOLS REQUIRED J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged. The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested. AFL/ECP Connectors AFL/EPC CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Electrical - Intermittent MIL/DTC P2138/Reduced Power Wiring Harness: All Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - Intermittent MIL/DTC P2138/Reduced Power TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 07-06-04-019D Date: June 28, 2010 Subject: Intermittent Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) Illuminated, DTC P2138 with Reduced Engine Power (Repair Instrument Panel (IP) to Body Harness Connector) Models: 2005-2011 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Including Saturn) 2005-2009 HUMMER H2 2006-2010 HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the model years and warranty information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 07-06-04-019C (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System) Condition - Some customers may comment on an intermittent malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) being Illuminated with a message or an indicator that displays Reduced Engine Power. - The technician may observe on a scan tool DTC P2138 - Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor 1-2 Correlation set as Current or in History. Cause This condition may be caused by water intrusion into the instrument panel (IP) to body harness connector, which carries the APP sensor signals to the ECM/PCM. This water intrusion results in a voltage difference between APP Sensor 1 and APP Sensor 2 that exceeds a predetermined value for more than a calibrated period of time, setting P2138. Correction Note Aftermarket equipment can generate DTC P2138 and/or other DTCs. 1. Verify that aftermarket equipment is not electrically connected to any of the APP sensor signal or low reference circuits or to any other ECM/PCM 5V reference or low reference circuits. Refer to Checking Aftermarket Accessories in SI. 2. Perform the Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle. ‹› If any 5V reference DTCs are set, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle. ‹› If any 5V reference DTCs are not set, proceed to Step 3. 3. Locate the IP to body harness connector, which may be located in and around the left hand kick panel area or inside the IP. Depending on the vehicle and model year, refer to Wiring Systems or Power and Signal Distribution in SI. Note Some examples of potential water leaks are: A-pillar seals, sunroof drain lines (if equipped) and windshield/cowl sealing. 4. Inspect for a water leak in the area. If necessary use a water hose to determine the source of the leak. Refer to General Information > Water Leaks in SI. ‹› If a water leak is observed, repair as necessary. Verify the effectiveness of the repair. 5. Inspect the IP to body harness connector terminals for corrosion and debris. Refer to Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections in SI. ‹› If any corrosion and/or debris is observed, repair as necessary. 6. After completing the repair, verify the proper operation of the system. Depending on the vehicle and model year, perform the Diagnostic Repair Verification procedure or refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle in SI. Locations Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Locations Immobilizer Component Views Behind Left Headlamp 1 - Headlamp Leveling Actuator - Left (TR6) 2 - Hood Ajar Switch (UA2) Page 7954 Important The M6 conductive rivet stud as shown, can accommodate a panel thickness range of 0.7-4.2 mm (0.03-0.17 in). If there are layers of sheet metal, they should be touching without any air gaps to ensure a good ground. 5. Select a M6 conductive rivet stud. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. Note Use the GE-50317 rivet stud tool kit. 6. Place the M6 conductive rivet stud (1) in the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole. Assemble the rivet stud tool (2) with the groove and flare side facing the rivet stud, then the washer and the M6 nut (3). 7. Using a wrench on the rivet stud tool, and a socket on the M6 nut, secure the M6 conductive rivet stud. 8. Ensure the rivet stud is securely fastened, WITHOUT ANY detectable movement. 9. Completely wrap the threads of the rivet stud with painters tape or equivalent. Note The rivet stud and surrounding panel area MUST BE properly refinished PRIOR to the installation of the ground wire terminal and conductive nut to maintain a secure, stable and corrosion-free electrical ground. 10. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and Repair in SI. 11. Allow the refinished repair area to cure sufficiently before removing the protective material applied to the rivet stud threads. 12. Remove the painters tape or equivalent from the rivet stud threads. 13. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, thoroughly clean the rivet stud threads to remove any adhesive and allow to dry. 14. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M6 conductive rivet stud. Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase. Page 6867 Locations Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay: Locations Fuse Block - Underhood (5.3L/6.0L), Label Page 4380 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (BSK) BOSCH CONNECTORS (BSK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 3. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 4. Insert the J 38125-561 tool into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 5. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is Page 1671 4. Install the fuel feed (1) and EVAP (2) lines to the sender assembly. 5. Install the fuel tank. Page 7461 Page 1847 - A control module from another vehicle is installed. - Revised software/calibration files have been released for this vehicle. - IMPORTANT: DO NOT re-program the control module with the SAME software/calibration files that are already present in the control module. This is not an effective repair for any type of concern. Verify that the control module contains the correct software/calibration. If incorrect programming is found, reprogram the control module with the most current software/calibration. Refer to Control Module References for replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Testing for Short to Ground TESTING FOR SHORT TO GROUND NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 4. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit. With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is a short to ground in the circuit. Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2. Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). - When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. - If the DMM does not display voltage 4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is shorted. Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A DIGITAL MULTIMETER NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the powertrain control module (PCM), should only be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200 Digital Multimeter (DMM). The J 39200 instruction manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminage even though voltage is present. The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity. IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading. Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the measurement. Page 1363 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the rear TPA from the connector. 7. IMPORTANT: The front TPA cannot be removed from the connector. Only move it to the release point. Use a small flat-blade tool to move the front TPA to the release position. 8. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 9. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Molex Connectors Page 5137 Engine Control Module: Locations Engine Controls Component Views Engine Control Module (ECM) 1 - Engine Control Module (ECM) 2 - Engine Control Module (ECM) C3 3 - Engine Control Module (ECM) C2 4 - Engine Control Module (ECM) C1 Page 3777 9. The illustration shows a cutaway view of the connector to aid the technician in releasing the terminal retainer. 10. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Terminal Position Assurance Locks TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Tyco/Amp Connectors (CM 42-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (CM 42-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the connector body and pull the CPA out. The CPA is on the wire harness side of connector. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 2654 Knock Sensor: Description and Operation Knock Sensor (KS) System Description Purpose The knock sensor (KS) system enables the control module to control the ignition timing for the best possible performance while protecting the engine from potentially damaging levels of detonation. The control module uses the KS system to test for abnormal engine noise that may indicate detonation, also known as spark knock. Sensor Description This knock sensor (KS) system uses one or 2 flat response 2-wire sensors. The sensor uses piezo-electric crystal technology that produces an AC voltage signal of varying amplitude and frequency based on the engine vibration or noise level. The control module receives the KS signal through a signal circuit. The KS ground is supplied by the control module through a low reference circuit. The control module learns a minimum noise level, or background noise, at idle from the KS and uses calibrated values for the rest of the RPM range. The control module uses the minimum noise level to calculate a noise channel. A normal KS signal will ride within the noise channel. As engine speed and load change, the noise channel upper and lower parameters will change to accommodate the normal KS signal, keeping the signal within the channel. In order to determine which cylinders are knocking, the control module only uses KS signal information when each cylinder is near top dead center (TDC) of the firing stroke. If knock is present, the signal will range outside of the noise channel. If the control module has determined that knock is present, it will retard the ignition timing to attempt to eliminate the knock. The control module will always try to work back to a zero compensation level, or no spark retard. An abnormal KS signal will stay outside of the noise channel or will not be present. KS diagnostics are calibrated to detect faults with the KS circuitry inside the control module, the KS wiring, or the KS voltage output. Some diagnostics are also calibrated to detect constant noise from an outside influence such as a loose/damaged component or excessive engine mechanical noise. Page 8951 7. The illustration above identifies the entry canal where the terminal release tool will be inserted, and the terminal cavity. - Terminal (1) - Entry Canal (2) 8. Insert the J-38125-553 (15315247) tool into the entry canal and pry up on the terminal retainer. The terminal retainer is a small plastic piece on the top of the terminal. The terminal retainer must be held up while the terminal is pulled out of the connector. Page 8438 7. Pressing the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool in the release cavity of the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and crimper in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (DOOR MODULE) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Side view of connector. View of top of connector. 1. Locate the assist lever and lock on the top of the connector. Page 7229 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Start in the middle and gradually move the heat barrel to the open ends of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Heated Oxygen Sensor Wiring Repairs HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being obstructed. If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. - Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks, etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire. - Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance. - To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector. Page 8938 2. Locate the two indents of the terminal position assurance (TPA) located on the bottom of the connector body. Page 8098 normal, replace the ECM. 6. Connect a test lamp between the relay coil B+ and the relay coil control circuit. 7. Ignition ON, command the powertrain relay ON and OFF with a scan tool. The test lamp should turn ON and OFF when changing between the commanded states. ‹› If the test lamp is always ON, test the relay coil control circuit for a short to ground. If the circuit tests normal, replace the ECM. ‹› If the test lamp is always OFF, test the relay coil control circuit for a short to voltage or an open/high resistance. If the circuit tests normal, replace the ECM. 8. Connect a 20A fused jumper wire between the relay switch B+ and the relay ignition 1 voltage circuit. 9. Ignition ON, engine OFF, monitor the EC Ignition Relay Feedback parameter with a scan tool. The parameter should display B+. ‹› If the parameter does not display B+, test the ignition 1 voltage circuit for an open/high resistance. If the circuit tests normal, replace the ECM. 10. If all circuits test normal, test or replace the relay. Component Testing 1. Ignition OFF, disconnect the powertrain relay. 2. Test for 65-110 ohms of resistance between terminals 85 and 86 of the relay. ‹› If the resistance is not within the specified range, replace the relay. 3. Test for infinite resistance between following terminals: * Terminal 30 and 86 * Terminal 30 and 87 * Terminal 30 and 85 * Terminal 85 and 87 ‹› If not the specified value, replace the relay. 4. Install a 20A fused jumper wire between relay terminal 85 and 12 volts. Install a jumper wire between relay terminal 86 and ground. Test for less than 1 ohm of resistance between terminals 30 and 87. ‹› If greater than the specified range, replace the relay. Repair Instructions Perform the Diagnostic Repair Verification after completing the diagnostic procedure. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests and Procedures * Relay Replacement (Attached to Wire Harness) Relay Replacement (Within an Electrical Center) * Underhood Electrical Center or Junction Block Replacement * Control Module References for ECM replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Page 1277 Turn Signal/Multifunction Switch C3 Page 2406 Camshaft Position Sensor: Connector Views Engine Controls Connector End Views Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor Page 4199 Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 9. Hand start the spark plug. Tighten the spark plug to 15 N.m (11 lb ft). 10. Install the spark plug wires at the ignition coil. 11. Install the spark plug wire to the spark plug. 12. Inspect the wires for proper installation: ^ Push sideways on each boot in order to check for proper installation. ^ Reinstall any loose boot. 13. Install the valve rocker arm. Refer to Valve Rocker Arm and Push Rod Replacement. Page 5593 5. While pushing the terminal forward, insert the J 38125-24 in the release cavity above the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (43-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Page 3070 Radiator Hose: Service and Repair Radiator Outlet Hose Replacement Radiator Outlet Hose Replacement (LH6, LS2) Tools Required J 38185 Hose Clamp Pliers Removal Procedure 1. Drain the cooling system. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System (LL8) Draining and Filling Cooling System (LH6, LS2). 2. Using J 38185 reposition the radiator outlet hose clamp (3). 3. Remove the radiator outlet hose (2) from the radiator. 4. Using J 38185 reposition the radiator outlet hose clamp. 5. Remove the radiator outlet hose from the engine (5). 6. Remove the radiator outlet hose. Installation Procedure Page 4648 7. Pressing the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool in the release cavity of the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and crimper in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (DOOR MODULE) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Side view of connector. View of top of connector. 1. Locate the assist lever and lock on the top of the connector. Page 4044 1. Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil. 2. Install the O-ring seal onto the oil level indicator tube. 3. Install the oil level indicator tube behind the exhaust manifold. 4. Raise and suitably support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 5. Install the oil level indicator tube into the block. Install the tube with the collar flush to the block. 6. Lower the vehicle. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 7. Install the oil level indicator tube bolt. Tighten the bolt to 25 N.m (18 lb ft). 8. Install the oil level indicator to the tube. 9. Install the cylinder number 2 spark plug and wire. Refer to Spark Plug Replacement OnStar(R) - Loss of GPS Signal/Hands Free Issues Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Loss of GPS Signal/Hands Free Issues Bulletin No.: 02-08-46-007C Date: November 19, 2007 INFORMATION Subject: Information on OnStar(R) System - Possible Loss of GPS Signal, Hands-Free Calling Minutes Expire Prematurely and/or Inability to Add Hands-Free Calling Minutes Models: 2001-2008 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Including Saturn) 2003-2008 HUMMER H2 2006-2008 HUMMER H3 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X with OnStar(R) System (RPO UE1) Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2008 model year, warranty information and to provide GPS signal recovery steps (under Dealer Action heading) to do PRIOR to determining if the VIU/VCIM needs replacement. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 02-08-46-007B (Section 08 - Body & Accessories). If the vehicle currently has analog-upgradable OnStar(R) hardware, then the customer should be made aware of the digital upgrade program per the latest version of Service Bulletin # 05-08-46-006. Any analog OnStar system that is not upgraded prior to the end of 2007 will be deactivated due to the upcoming phase-out of the analog cellular network in the U.S. and Canada. If the vehicle has recently been upgraded or has had a service replacement unit installed, this bulletin may not be applicable. Certain 2001-2008 model year vehicles equipped with OnStar(R) may exhibit a condition with the Global Positioning System (GPS) that causes inaccuracies in the GPS clock. The GPS system is internal to the OnStar(R) Vehicle Interface Unit (VIU) or the Vehicle Communication Interface Module (VCIM). This inaccuracy can result in a symptom where the OnStar(R) Call Center is unable to obtain an accurate GPS signal, hands-Free Calling minutes expire prematurely and/or the inability to add Hands-Free calling minutes. Customer Notification OnStar(R) will notify the customer by mail with instructions to contact their dealership service department. Dealer Action Not all vehicles will require VIU/VCIM replacement. The GPS signal in some vehicles may be recoverable. To determine if the signal is recoverable, simply connect the Tech2(R) and using the GPS information data display option, observe the GPS date and time. If the date/time stamps are equal to a date approximately 19 years in the future, the GPS clock has exceeded its capacity and the VIU/VCIM will need to be replaced. If the date/time stamp is in the past or near future, the GPS clock has simply generated an inaccurate value and may be recoverable by performing the following power-up reset. To initiate a power-up reset, battery voltage (batt. +) must be removed from the VIU/VCIM. The preferred methods, in order, of initiating the reset are outlined below. Remove the fuse that supplies Battery positive (Batt. +) voltage to the module (refer to the applicable Service Information schematics for the appropriate fuse). The next preferred method is to remove the connector to the OnStar(R) unit that Batt + is contained. The least preferable method is to remove the negative terminal of the vehicle battery. This will not only initiate the power-up reset, but it may also result in the loss of radio presets and other stored personalization information/settings in other modules as well. After initiating the power-up reset, the GPS data will be set to the defaulted date and time and will require an acquisition of the GPS signal in order to gain the proper date and time. Acquiring the GPS signal requires running the vehicle in an open/unobstructed view of the sky. First, contact OnStar(R) Technical Support by pressing the blue button. Allow the OnStar(R) Technical Advisor to activate the GPS recovery process. This should take approximately 10 minutes. Continue to Page 7783 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert terminal into the appropriate terminal holder until it hits bottom and stops. The correct terminal holder is determined by the wire size. Also ensure that the terminals wings are pointing towards the former on the tool and the release locator. 5. Insert the stripped cable into the terminal. Insulation should be visible on both sides of the terminal insulation wings. 6. Compress the handles until the ratchet automatically releases. 7. Place the terminal into the appropriate cavity and assemble the connector. Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO-PACK 100W) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W connectors. These connectors are very similar but use different terminals and have some minor physical differences also. Page 4620 7. Apply pressure and gently rock the cover until one locking leg is unseated. 8. Continue to apply pressure and rock the cover until the second locking leg is unseated. Repeat procedure for the other side of the dress cover and remove the cover. 9. Use J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) to gently lift the terminal retaining tab while gently pulling the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 10. If the terminal is severely bent or damaged, it may be possible on some connectors to push the wire out of the front of the connector instead of Page 8830 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. 4. Remove the dress cover by using a flat bladed tool to release the dress cover locking tabs and lift up on the dress cover. 5. Cut the tie wrap that holds the wires to the connector body. Page 4181 9. Install the EVAP purge solenoid vent tubes (1, 2). Refer to Plastic Collar Quick Connect Fitting Service. 10. Install the heater water shutoff valve actuator inlet hose to the intake manifold. Page 2935 Drive Belt: Testing and Inspection Drive Belt Falls Off and Excessive Wear Diagnosis Drive Belt Falls Off and Excessive Wear Diagnosis Diagnostic Aids If the drive belt repeatedly falls off the drive belt pulleys, this is because of pulley misalignment. An extra load that is quickly applied on released by an accessory drive component may cause the drive belt to fall off the pulleys. Verify the accessory drive components operate properly. If the drive belt is the incorrect length, the drive belt tensioner may not keep the proper tension on the drive belt. Excessive wear on a drive belt is usually caused by an incorrect installation or the wrong drive belt for the application. Minor misalignment of the drive belt pulleys will not cause excessive wear, but will probably cause the drive belt to make a noise or to fall off. Excessive misalignment of the drive belt pulleys will cause excessive wear but may also make the drive belt fall off. Test Description The numbers below refer to the step numbers on the diagnostic table. 2. This inspection is to verify the condition of the drive belt. Damage may have occurred to the drive belt when the drive belt fell off. The drive belt may of been damaged, which caused the drive belt to fall off. Inspect the belt for cuts, tears, sections of ribs missing, or damaged belt plys. 4. Misalignment of the pulleys may be caused from improper mounting of the accessory drive component, incorrect installation of the accessory drive component pulley, or the pulley bent inward or outward from a previous repair. Test for a misaligned pulley using a straight edge in the pulley grooves across 2 or 3 pulleys. If a misaligned pulley is found refer to that accessory drive component for the proper installation procedure of that pulley. 5. Inspecting the pulleys for being bent should include inspecting for a dent or other damage to the pulleys that would prevent the drive belt from not seating properly in all of the pulley grooves or on the smooth surface of a pulley when the back side of the belt is used to drive the pulley. 6. Accessory drive component brackets that are bent or cracked will let the drive belt fall off. 7. Inspecting of the fasteners can eliminate the possibility that a wrong bolt, nut, spacer, or washer was installed. Missing. loose, or the wrong fasteners may cause pulley misalignment from the bracket moving under load. Over tightening of the fasteners may cause misalignment of the accessory component bracket. 13. The inspection is to verify the drive belt is correctly installed on all of the drive belt pulleys. Wear on the drive belt may be caused by mis-positioning the drive belt by one groove on a pulley. 14. The installation of a drive belt that is too wide or too narrow will cause wear on the drive belt. The drive belt ribs should match all of the grooves on all of the pulleys. 15. This inspection is to verify the drive belt is not contacting any parts of the engine or body while the engine is operating. There should be sufficient clearance when the drive belt accessory drive components load varies. The drive belt should not come in contact with an engine or a body component when snapping the throttle. Page 7355 View of a typical Micro 64 connector. Depress the lock and pull the lever over and past the lock. Page 6109 4. Use a small flat-blade tool to slide the terminal position assurance (TPA) up one notch on both ends of the connector. The TPA is located underneath the wire dress cover. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 8587 breakers are used. CIRCUIT BREAKER This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high current is removed. POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) CIRCUIT BREAKER This type greatly increases its resistance when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker will re-close within a second or 2. Circuit Protection - Fuses CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSES The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and examine the element in the fuse for an open (2). If not broken (1), also check for continuity using a DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one of equal current rating. Circuit Protection - Fusible Links CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSIBLE LINKS Page 7601 Knock Sensor: Diagnostic Aids Arrows and Symbols Arrows and Symbols This Service Data uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations. Arrows and Symbols 1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow Basic Knowledge Required GENERAL ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures contained in the service manual. You should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current (amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram, as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. Decimal and Metric Equivalents Decimal and Metric Equivalents Page 4284 Air Filter Element: Service and Repair Air Cleaner Element Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Remove the air cleaner outlet duct. 2. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF)/intake air temperature (IAT) sensor electrical connector (1). 3. Remove the radiator support diagonal brace. 4. Loosen the 4 air cleaner cover retaining screws (1). 5. Remove the air cleaner housing cover (2). Lift and rotate the cover in order to remove the cover from the vehicle. 6. Remove the air filter element (6) and the MAF/IAT sensor (3) from the lower air cleaner housing/washer solvent tank assembly (4). 7. Separate the air filter element (6) from the MAF/IAT sensor (3). 8. Inspect the entire assembly for dust, debris, or water. Clean or replace as necessary. Installation Procedure Page 5599 View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. 4. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers CIRCUIT PROTECTION - CIRCUIT BREAKERS A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types of circuit Page 6580 8. Insert the J 38125-213 into the small terminal release hole on the nose piece and gently pull on the back of the wire. 9. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Repairing Connector Terminals REPAIRING CONNECTOR TERMINALS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following: Push to Seat terminals - Pull to Seat terminals Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your terminal repair. The J-38125 contains further information. 1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.For cable seal terminals, remove the seal. 2. Apply the correct cable seal per gage size of the wire, if used.Slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation removal. 3. Remove the insulation. 4. For sealed terminals only, align the seal with the end of the cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal.For sealed terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal. 6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.For sealed terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable. 8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals excepting Micro-Pack 100.64 size. Soldering Micro-Pack 100 World terminals may damage the terminal. Sumitomo Connectors SUMITOMO CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 5457 2. Locate the two indents of the terminal position assurance (TPA) located on the bottom of the connector body. Engine/Transmission - Aftermarket Calibrations Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine/Transmission - Aftermarket Calibrations INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 09-06-04-026C Date: August 13, 2010 Subject: Identifying Non-GM (Aftermarket) Engine and Transmission Calibrations for V8 Gas Engines Using Tech 2(R) or Global Diagnostic System (GDS) Models: 2006-2011 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Excluding Saab 9-7X) 2006-2009 HUMMER H2 2006-2010 HUMMER H3 Equipped with V8 Gas Powered Engines Only Attention: This bulletin applies to V8 gas powered engines ONLY. For Duramax(TM) diesel powered engines, refer to the latest version of Corporate Bulletin Number 08-06-04-006G. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2011 model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 09-06-04-026A (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). General Motors is identifying an increasing number of engine, transmission and catalytic converter part failures that are the result of non-GM (aftermarket) engine and transmission control calibrations being used. When alteration to the GM-released engine or transmission control calibrations occurs, it subjects powertrain and driveline components (engine , transmission, transfer case, driveshaft and rear axle) to stresses that were not tested by General Motors. It is because of these unknown stresses, and the potential to alter reliability, durability and emissions performance, that GM has adopted a policy that prevents any UNAUTHORIZED dealer warranty claim submissions to any remaining warranty coverage, to the powertrain and driveline components whenever the presence of a non-GM (aftermarket) calibration is confirmed - even if the non-GM control module calibration is subsequently removed. Warranty coverage is based on the equipment and calibrations that were released on the vehicle at time of sale, or subsequently updated by GM. That's because GM testing and validation matches the calibration to a host of criteria that is essential to assure reliability, durability and emissions performance over the life of the warranty coverage and beyond. Stresses resulting from calibrations different from those tested and released by GM can damage or weaken components, leading to poor performance and or shortened life. Additionally, non-GM (aftermarket) issued engine control modifications often do not meet the same emissions performance standards as GM issued calibrations. Depending on state statutes, individuals who install engine control module calibrations that put the vehicle outside the parameters of emissions certification standards may be subject to fines and/or penalties. This bulletin outlines a procedure to identify the presence of non-GM (aftermarket) calibrations. GM recommends performing this check whenever a hard part failure is seen on internal engine or transmission components, or before an engine assembly or transmission assembly is being replaced under warranty. It is also recommended that the engine calibration verification procedure be performed whenever diagnostics indicate that catalytic converter replacement is indicated. The PQC has a process to confirm the ECM/PCM calibration is GM issued. The PQC will require a picture of the engine calibration verification screen, as outlined in this bulletin, before authorizing any V8 gas powered engine replacement. If a non-GM calibration is found and verification has taken place through GM, the remaining powertrain and driveline warranty will be blocked and notated in GMVIS and the dealership will be notified. This block prevents any UNAUTHORIZED warranty claim submission. 1. Connect the Tech 2(R) to the vehicle. 2. Go to: Diagnostics and build the vehicle. 3. Select: Powertrain. 4. Select: Engine. 5. *Select: Engine Control Module or PCM. 6. *Select: Module ID Information or I/M Information System if the Module ID Information selection is not available. 7. *If "I/M information System" was selected, it may be necessary to select "Vehicle Information" in order to display the calibration information. ‹› If the CVN information is displayed as "N/A", it will be necessary to contact the TCSC to obtain the CVN information. Page 1972 It is very important to use the correct test adapter when testing for proper terminal contact of fuses and relays in a bussed electrical center (BEC). Use J-35616-35 to test for proper terminal contact. Failure to use J-35616-35 can result in improper diagnosis of the BEC. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Separate the connector halves. 2. Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body. 3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J-38125 , test that the retention force is significantly different between a good terminal and a suspect terminal. Replace the female terminal in question. FLAT WIRE (DOCK AND LOCK) CONNECTORS There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock) connectors on the harness side or the component side. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Remove the component in question. 2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side of the connector as oil from your skin may be a source of contamination as well. 3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other imperfections that could cause poor terminal contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are uniform and free of damage or deformation. 4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the on the flat wire harness connector in order to test the circuit in question. CONTROL MODULE/COMPONENT VOLTAGE AND GROUNDS Poor voltage or ground connections can cause widely varying symptoms. Test all control module voltage supply circuits. Many vehicles have multiple circuits supplying voltage to a control module. Other components in the system may have separate voltage supply circuits that may also need to be tested. Inspect connections at the module/component connectors, fuses, and any intermediate connections between the voltage source and the module/component. A test lamp or a DMM may indicate that voltage is present, but neither tests the ability of the circuit to carry sufficient current. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Power Distribution Schematics. - Test all control module ground and system ground circuits. The control module may have multiple ground circuits. Other components in the system may have separate grounds that may also need to be tested. Inspect grounds for clean and tight connections at the grounding point. Inspect the connections at the component and in splice packs, where applicable. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Ground Distribution Schematics. TEMPERATURE SENSITIVITY - An intermittent condition may occur when a component/connection reaches normal operating temperature. The condition may occur only when the component/connection is cold, or only when the component/connection is hot. - Freeze Frame, Failure Records, Snapshot, or Vehicle Data Recorder data may help with this type of intermittent condition, where applicable. - If the intermittent is related to heat, review the data for a relationship with the following: High ambient temperatures - Underhood/engine generated heat - Circuit generated heat due to a poor connection, or high electrical load - Higher than normal load conditions, towing, etc. - If the intermittent is related to cold, review the data for the following: Low ambient temperatures-In extremely low temperatures, ice may form in a connection or component. Inspect for water intrusion. - The condition only occurs on a cold start. - The condition goes away when the vehicle warms up. - Information from the customer may help to determine if the trouble follows a pattern that is temperature related. - If temperature is suspected of causing an intermittent fault condition, attempt to duplicate the condition. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required. ELECTROMAGNETIC INTERFERENCE (EMI) AND ELECTRICAL NOISE Some electrical components/circuits are sensitive to electromagnetic interference (EMI) or other types of electrical noise. Inspect for the following conditions: A misrouted harness that is too close to high voltage/high current devices such as secondary ignition components, motors, generator etc-These components may induce electrical noise on a circuit that could interfere with normal circuit operation. - Electrical system interference caused by a malfunctioning relay, or a control module driven solenoid or switch-These conditions can cause a sharp electrical surge. Normally, the condition will occur when the malfunctioning component is operating. - Improper installation of non-factory or aftermarket add on accessories such as lights, 2-way radios, amplifiers, electric motors, remote starters, alarm systems, cell phones, etc-These accessories may lead to interference while in use, but do not fail when the accessories are not in use. - Test for an open diode across the A/C compressor clutch and for other open diodes. Some relays may contain a clamping diode. - The generator may be allowing AC noise into the electrical system. INCORRECT CONTROL MODULE - There are only a few situations where reprogramming a control module is appropriate: A new service control module is installed. Page 808 Page 4738 Flushing Procedures using DEX-COOL(R) Important: The following procedure recommends refilling the system with DEX-COOL(R), P/N 12346290 (in Canada, use P/N 10953464), GM specification 6277M. This coolant is orange in color and has a service interval of 5 years or 240,000 km (150,000 mi). However, when used on vehicles built prior to the introduction of DEX-COOL(R), maintenance intervals will remain the same as specified in the Owner's Manual. ^ If available, use the approved cooling system flush and fill machine (available through the GM Dealer Equipment Program) following the manufacturer's operating instructions. ^ If approved cooling system flush and fill machine is not available, drain the coolant and dispose of properly following the draining procedures in the appropriate Service Manual. Refill the system using clear, drinkable water and run the vehicle until the thermostat opens. Repeat and run the vehicle three (3) times to totally remove the old coolant or until the drained coolant is almost clear. Once the system is completely flushed, refill the cooling system to a 50%-60% concentration with DEX‐COOL(R), P/N 12346290 (in Canada, use P/N 10953464), GM specification 6277M, following the refill procedures in the appropriate Service Manual. If a Service Manual is not available, fill half the capacity of the system with 100% DEX-COOL(R), P/N 12346290 (in Canada, use P/N 10953464), GM specification 6277M. Then slowly add clear, drinkable water (preferably distilled) to the system until the level of the coolant mixture has reached the base of the radiator neck. Wait two (2) minutes and reverify the coolant level. If necessary, add clean water to restore the coolant to the appropriate level. Once the system is refilled, reverify the coolant concentration using a Refractometer J 23688 (Fahrenheit scale) or J 26568 (centigrade scale) coolant tester, or equivalent. The concentration levels should be between 50% and 65%. Flushing Procedures using Conventional Silicated (Green Colored) Coolant Important: 2004-2005 Chevrolet Aveo (Pontiac Wave, Canada Only) does not use DEX‐COOL(R). The Aveo and Wave are filled with conventional, silicated engine coolant that is blue in color. Silicated coolants are typically green in color and are required to be drained, flushed and refilled every 30,000 miles (48,000 km). The Aveo and Wave are to be serviced with conventional, silicated coolant. Use P/N 12378560 (1 gal) (in Canada, use P/N 88862159 (1 L). Refer to the Owner's Manual or Service Information (SI) for further information on OEM coolant. Important: Do not mix the OEM orange colored DEX-COOL(R) coolant with green colored coolant when adding coolant to the system or when servicing the vehicle's cooling system. Mixing the orange and green colored coolants will produce a brown coolant which may be a customer dissatisfier and will not extend the service interval to that of DEX-COOL(R). Conventional silicated coolants offered by GM Service and Parts Operations are green in color. ^ If available, use the approved cooling system flush and fill machine (available through the GM Dealer Equipment Program) following the manufacturer's operating instructions. ^ If approved cooling systems flush and fill machine is not available, drain coolant and dispose of properly following the draining procedures in appropriate Service Manual. Refill the system using clear, drinkable water and run vehicle until thermostat opens. Repeat and run vehicle three (3) times to totally remove old coolant or until drained coolant is almost clear. Once the system is completely flushed, refill the cooling system to a 50%-60% concentration with a good quality ethylene glycol base engine coolant, P/N 12378560, 1 gal (in Canada, use P/N 88862159 1 L), conforming to GM specification 1825M, or recycled coolant conforming to GM specification 1825M, following the refill procedures in the appropriate Service Manual. If a Service Manual is not available, fill half the capacity of the system with 100% good quality ethylene glycol base (green colored) engine coolant, P/N 12378560 1 gal., (in Canada, use P/N 88862159 1 L) conforming to GM specification 1825M. Then slowly add clear, drinkable water (preferably distilled) to system until the level of the coolant mixture has reached the base of the radiator neck. Wait two (2) minutes and recheck coolant level. If necessary, add clean water to restore coolant to the appropriate level. Once the system is refilled, recheck the coolant concentration using a Refractometer J 23688 (Fahrenheit scale) or J 26568 (centigrade scale) coolant tester, or equivalent. Concentration levels should be between 50% and 65%. Parts Information Warranty Information Wheels - Chrome Wheel Brake Dust Accumulation/Pitting Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels - Chrome Wheel Brake Dust Accumulation/Pitting Bulletin No.: 04-03-10-012B Date: February 01, 2008 INFORMATION Subject: Pitting and Brake Dust on Chrome wheels Models: 2008 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2008 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 04-03-10-012A (Section 03 - Suspension). Analysis of Returned Wheels Chrome wheels returned under the New Vehicle Limited Warranty for pitting concerns have recently been evaluated. This condition is usually most severe in the vent (or window) area of the front wheels. This "pitting" may actually be brake dust that has been allowed to accumulate on the wheel. The longer this accumulation builds up, the more difficult it is to remove. Cleaning the Wheels In all cases, the returned wheels could be cleaned to their original condition using GM Vehicle Care Cleaner Wax, P/N 12377966 (in Canada, P/N 10952905). When using this product, you should confine your treatment to the areas of the wheel that show evidence of the brake dust build-up. This product is only for use on chromed steel or chromed aluminum wheels. Parts Information Warranty Information Wheel replacement for this condition is NOT applicable under the terms of the New Vehicle Limited Warranty. Disclaimer Page 6401 Page 1651 11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the solder equipment. 12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. 13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to cover the first piece of tape. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE SLEEVES TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit IMPORTANT: Use only dura seal splice sleeves. Other splice sleeves may not protect the splice from moisture or provide a good electrical connection. Use duraseal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. Use duraseal splice sleeves where there is special requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire using duraseal splice sleeves. Page 7063 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the rear TPA from the connector. 7. IMPORTANT: The front TPA cannot be removed from the connector. Only move it to the release point. Use a small flat-blade tool to move the front TPA to the release position. 8. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 9. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Molex Connectors Page 1479 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. 4. Remove the dress cover by using a flat bladed tool to release the dress cover locking tabs and lift up on the dress cover. 5. Cut the tie wrap that holds the wires to the connector body. Page 2247 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. JST Connectors JST CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, remove the connector from the component. Page 814 Page 701 5. Insert the J 38125-557 (GM P/N 12122378) into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 6. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Connector Position Assurance Locks CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of the connector. CPAs are used in various connectors throughout the vehicle. CPAs are also used in all SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals, of the connector. Connector Repairs CONNECTOR REPAIRS Page 5491 Open the harness by removing any tape. 2. Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. 3. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 4. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent american wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 5. Slide a section of high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing down the length of wire to be spliced. Ensure that the shrink tubing will not interfere with the splice procedure. 6. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 7. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. 8. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 9. Insert the wire into the DuraSeal splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 10. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Page 5871 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert a small flat-blade tool in the slot below the front loaded terminal position assurance (TPA) and pry up. 3. Remove the TPA by pulling it out of the connector. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-553 (GM P/N 15315247) on a slight upward angle into the cavity below the terminal to be removed. Ensure that the pointed on the end of the tool is facing the bottom of the terminal and it stays in contact with the terminal until it stops on the plastic terminal retainer. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 8319 If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs SIR/SRS WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS, and the wiring components, such as connectors and terminals. IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system terminals. Use either an SIR/SRS pigtail or a terminated lead from the SIR Repair Kit Tray. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves, in order to repair the SIR/SRS wiring - A special crimping tool - A heat torch - An instruction manual The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides the necessary low resistance contact integrity for these sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors SIR/SRS CONNECTOR REPAIR (PLASTIC BODY AND TERMINAL METAL PIN) The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made with a special plating. This plating provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. Use the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit for repairing SIR/SRS terminals and connectors. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the repair kit. The J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit contains: Various terminated leads for sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) terminal replacement - Various connector positive assurance (CPA) locks for SIR/SRS connectors - Base of steering column pigtail connectors part number 12085514 - Yellow vinyl electrical tape Pigtail repair packs are available for SIR/SRS connectors with eight or less terminals. Only the connector body is available for connectors with more than eight terminals. The terminated leads in the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit can be used to replace damaged terminals when replacing the connector body. SIR/SRS COMPONENT WIRE PIGTAIL REPAIR IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails. A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device, not by a connector. If a wiring pigtail is damaged, you must replace the entire component, with pigtail. The inflatable restraint steering wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component. SIR/SRS WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 297 Beneath Driver Seat Cushion Page 6245 3. Remove the dress cover by using a flat-blade tool to release the connector locking tabs and pulling off the dress cover. 4. Relieve the tension on the nose piece retainers by inserting J-38125-12A (12094429) into the single retainer slot on the end of the nose piece and gently prying out the locking tab. Repeat the process for both of the nose piece locking tabs on the opposite side of the nose piece. Capacity Specifications Coolant: Capacity Specifications Cooling System ................................................................................................................................... .............................................. 11.2 quarts (10.6 liters) NOTE: All capacities are approximate. When adding, be sure to fill to the approximate level. Recheck fluid level after filling. Engine - Valve Lifter Tick Noise At Start Up Oil Filter: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Valve Lifter Tick Noise At Start Up TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 10-06-01-007C Date: February 09, 2011 Subject: Active Fuel Management (AFM) Engine, Valve Lifter Tick Noise at Start Up When Engine Has Been Off for 2 Hours or More (Evaluate Noise and/or Replace Valve Lifters) Models: 2007 Buick Rainier 2009 Buick LaCrosse Super, Allure Super (Canada Only) 2007 Cadillac Escalade Built Prior to April 1, 2006 with 6.2L Engine RPO L92 (These engines were built with AFM Hardware but the AFM system was disabled) 2010-2011 Cadillac Escalade, Escalade ESV, Escalade EXT 2007 Chevrolet Monte Carlo 2007-2009 Chevrolet Impala 2007-2011 Chevrolet Avalanche, Silverado, Suburban, Tahoe, TrailBlazer, TrailBlazer EXT 2010-2011 Chevrolet Camaro SS 2007-2011 GMC Envoy, Envoy XL, Sierra, Yukon, Yukon Denali, Yukon XL, Yukon XL Denali 2007-2008 Pontiac Grand Prix 2008-2009 Pontiac G8 2007-2009 Saab 9-7X Equipped with AFM (Active Fuel Management) and V8 Engine RPO L76, L94, L99, LC9, LFA, LH6, LMG, LS4, LY5 or LZ1 Attention: This bulletin only applies to the AFM V8 engines listed above. It DOES NOT apply to Non-AFM Engines. If you are dealing with a Non-AFM engine that is experiencing a similar noise, please refer to Engine Mechanical > Diagnostic Information and Procedures > Symptoms in SI. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add models. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 10-06-01-007B (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). Condition Some customers may comment on an engine valve lifter tick noise that occurs after the engine has been shut off for at least two hours. The tick noise may last from two seconds to ten minutes. Cause This condition may be caused by any of the following: - Aerated oil in the valve lifter body, resulting in the valve lifter being unable to purge the air quickly. - A low engine oil level or incorrect oil viscosity. - Dirty or contaminated oil. - A low internal valve lifter oil reservoir level. - Debris in the valve lifter. - A high valve lifter leak down rate. Correction If the SI diagnostics do not isolate the cause of this valve lifter tick noise and normal oil pressure is noted during the concern, perform the following steps: 1. Inspect the engine oil condition and level. Refer to Owner Manual > Service and Appearance Care > Checking Things Under the Hood > Description and Operation > Engine Oil in SI. ‹› If the engine oil is more than one quart low, an incorrect oil viscosity is being used or if poor quality/contamination is observed, change the oil and filter. Note Service and Repair Blower Motor Relay: Service and Repair Blower Motor Relay Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Remove the cover of the under hood fuse block. 2. Remove the blower motor relay (1) from the under hood fuse block (2). Installation Procedure 1. Install the blower motor relay (1) to the under hood fuse block. 2. Install the cover of the under hood fuse block. Page 7995 3. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. View showing depressing of the lever lock release tab. Page 6133 5. While pushing the terminal forward, insert the J 38125-24 in the release cavity above the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (43-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Page 3781 4. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the rear of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. 5. Once the locking tabs are unlocked, slide the inner connector out of the rear of the connector housing. Page 2971 For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 2259 3. Remove the dress cover by using a flat-blade tool to release the connector locking tabs and pulling off the dress cover. 4. Relieve the tension on the nose piece retainers by inserting J-38125-12A (12094429) into the single retainer slot on the end of the nose piece and gently prying out the locking tab. Repeat the process for both of the nose piece locking tabs on the opposite side of the nose piece. Page 5345 3. Remove the dress cover by using a flat-blade tool to release the connector locking tabs and pulling off the dress cover. 4. Relieve the tension on the nose piece retainers by inserting J-38125-12A (12094429) into the single retainer slot on the end of the nose piece and gently prying out the locking tab. Repeat the process for both of the nose piece locking tabs on the opposite side of the nose piece. Page 4659 2. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully push the terminal position assurance (TPA) towards the face of the connector on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA is fragile and may break if not done carefully. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. 3. Use the J 38125-215 tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 4567 Page 7533 9. The illustration shows a cutaway view of the connector to aid the technician in releasing the terminal retainer. 10. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Terminal Position Assurance Locks TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Tyco/Amp Connectors (CM 42-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (CM 42-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the connector body and pull the CPA out. The CPA is on the wire harness side of connector. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 8808 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert terminal into the appropriate terminal holder until it hits bottom and stops. The correct terminal holder is determined by the wire size. Also ensure that the terminals wings are pointing towards the former on the tool and the release locator. 5. Insert the stripped cable into the terminal. Insulation should be visible on both sides of the terminal insulation wings. 6. Compress the handles until the ratchet automatically releases. 7. Place the terminal into the appropriate cavity and assemble the connector. Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO-PACK 100W) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W connectors. These connectors are very similar but use different terminals and have some minor physical differences also. Page 8188 6. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by pressing on the tang. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (SENSOR) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) tool into the cavity on the lower right hand face of the connector until the terminal release tang access panel slides over. Page 1608 REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. The release tab is located on the top of the wiredress cover. View of connector in released position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Page 6885 3. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. View showing depressing of the lever lock release tab. Specifications Piston: Specifications Pistons and Pins Pin - Piston Pin Clearance-to-Piston Pin Bore Production ........................................................................................................................................................... 0.002-0.01 mm (0.00008-0.0004 in) Service .............................................................................................................................................................. 0.002-0.015 mm (0.00008-0.0006 in) Pin - Piston Pin Diameter .......................................................................................................................................... 23.952-23.955 mm (0.943-0.943 in) Pin - Piston Pin Fit in Connecting Rod Bore Production ......................................................................................................................................................... 0.007-0.02 mm (0.00027-0.00078 in) Service ............................................................................................................................................................ 0.007-0.022 mm (0.00027-0.00086 in) Piston - Piston Diameter - Measured Over Skirt Coating ............................................................................................ 96.002-96.036 mm (3.779-3.78 in) Piston - Piston-to-Bore Clearance Production ............................................................................................................................................ -0.036 to +0.016 mm (-0.0014 to +0.0006 in) Service Limit with Skirt Coating Worn Off ............................................................................................................................... 0.071 mm (0.0028 in) Page 6221 2. Locate the nose piece locking tabs that are positioned on the side of the connector nose piece. The connector nose piece acts as a terminal positive assurance (TPA) and may be referred to as such. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to push in one of the locking tabs while gently pulling on the same side of the nose piece. 4. Repeat the procedure for the other locking tab and remove the nose piece. 5. Remove the wire dress cover. The following is a general procedure for wire dress cover removal. Use this procedure as a guide, some dress cover removal procedures may vary. 6. Use fingers to squeeze the 2 locking legs of the cover. Page 544 If a wire is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm, etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except coaxial. - Do not use the DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent American wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 4896 Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested: - Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. - Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a component or to other harnesses. - If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A TEST LAMP TOOLS REQUIRED J 35616-200 Test Light - Probe Kit NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminate even though voltage is present. The J 35616-200 is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair of leads. To properly operate this tool use the following procedures. When testing for voltage: 1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested. When testing for ground: 1. Attach one lead to battery positive voltage. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where ground should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is ground at the point being tested. Using Connector Test Adapters USING CONNECTOR TEST ADAPTERS NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Using Fused Jumper Wires USING FUSED JUMPER WIRES TOOLS REQUIRED J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged. The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested. AFL/ECP Connectors AFL/EPC CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 3750 2. Locate the nose piece locking tabs that are positioned on the side of the connector nose piece. The connector nose piece acts as a terminal positive assurance (TPA) and may be referred to as such. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to push in one of the locking tabs while gently pulling on the same side of the nose piece. 4. Repeat the procedure for the other locking tab and remove the nose piece. 5. Remove the wire dress cover. The following is a general procedure for wire dress cover removal. Use this procedure as a guide, some dress cover removal procedures may vary. 6. Use fingers to squeeze the 2 locking legs of the cover. Page 3127 Fluid - Differential: Removal and Replacement Rear Axle Lubricant Replacement (9.5 LD Inch Axle) Removal Procedure 1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 2. Remove the drain plug. 3. Remove the fill plug. Installation Procedure Locations Power Door Lock Switch: Locations Driver Door Module (DDM) Page 8090 Notice: Refer to Handling Electrostatic Discharge Sensitive Parts Notice. Important: * It is not necessary to disconnect the ECM electrical connectors in order to remove the ECM from the ECM/TCM bracket. Only disconnect the electrical connectors if servicing of component requires disconnecting of the electrical connectors. * Remove any debris from around the ECM connector surfaces before servicing the ECM. Inspect the ECM module connector gaskets when diagnosing or replacing the ECM. Ensure that the gaskets are installed correctly. The gaskets prevent contaminant intrusion into the ECM. Disconnect the engine wiring harness electrical connectors from the ECM. 6. Release the ECM/TCM bracket upper retainers (1). 7. Tilt the ECM away from the bracket and remove the ECM. Page 4922 7. Apply pressure and gently rock the cover until one locking leg is unseated. 8. Continue to apply pressure and rock the cover until the second locking leg is unseated. Repeat procedure for the other side of the dress cover and remove the cover. 9. Use J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) to gently lift the terminal retaining tab while gently pulling the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 10. If the terminal is severely bent or damaged, it may be possible on some connectors to push the wire out of the front of the connector instead of Page 3522 13. Use the tire changer in order to install the tire to the wheel. Caution: To avoid serious personal injury, do not stand over tire when inflating. The bead may break when the bead snaps over the safety hump. Do not exceed 275 kPa (40 psi) pressure when inflating any tire if beads are not seated. If 275 kPa (40 psi) pressure will not seat the beads, deflate, lubricate the beads and reinflate. Overinflating may cause the bead to break and cause serious personal injury. Important: Allowable bead seating pressure is 345 kPa (50 psi) on Extended Mobility Tires. 14. Inflate the tire until it passes the bead humps. Be sure that the valve core is not installed at this time. 15. Install the valve core to the valve core stem. 16. Inflate the tire to the proper air pressure. 17. Ensure that the locating rings are visible on both sides of the tire in order to verify that the tire bead is fully seated on the wheel. Parts Information The product shown above is available from GM SPO. Disclaimer Page 1691 Page 5521 Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids Arrows and Symbols Arrows and Symbols This Service Data uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations. Arrows and Symbols 1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow Basic Knowledge Required GENERAL ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures contained in the service manual. You should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current (amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram, as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. Decimal and Metric Equivalents Decimal and Metric Equivalents Page 6339 The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors. 1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position. 4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool J 38125-10A (GM P/N 12014012-1) into the front (mating end) of the connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal through the back of the connector (2). IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector. 6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. 7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily. 10. Perform system check. Delphi Connectors (12 Way) DELPHI CONNECTORS (12-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. Page 3682 * The black negative (-) cable must be first disconnected from the vehicle that was boosted (4). * Disconnect the black negative (-) cable from the negative (-) terminal (3) of the booster battery. Notice: Do not let the cable end touch any metal. Damage to the battery and other components may result. * Disconnect the red positive (+) cable from the positive (+) terminal (1) of the booster battery. * Disconnect the red positive (+) cable from the remote positive (+) terminal (2) of the vehicle with the discharged battery. Page 6564 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) and slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. Page 849 The first connector design of the Micro-Pack 100W (1) has a white connector interface that holds the terminals. The second design of the Micro-Pack 100W (2) has a gray interface to hold the terminals. Also, the first design has terminal cavities that are further apart (3 mm centerline) and offset from the other row of terminal cavities in the connector. The second design has terminals cavities that are closer together (2.54 mm centerline) and aligned vertically. One other way to identify the second design is the thin strip of material that runs along the outside of the cavities. IMPORTANT: There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W terminals which are very similar. Ensure that you have the correct terminal before crimping the new terminal to the wire. The first design connector uses the longer terminal (1) that has a raised area in front of the recess in the terminal. The second design connector uses the shorter terminal without the raised area. Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro-Pack 100W connectors. Some Micro-Pack 100W connector disassembly procedures will vary. Use this procedure as a guide. 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 1875 pulling it through. This will prevent damage to the internal seals of the connector. Once the terminal is pushed out of the connector, cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible and pull the wire through the connector. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE The Micro-Pack 100W connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool was developed to crimp Micro-Pack 100W terminals. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 2. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert the terminal into the crimp tool until the core wings are flush with the anvil on the crimp tool. Be sure that the wings are pointed toward the crimp tool former and release the spring locator. The locator will hold the terminal in place. Inspect the alignment of the terminal wings with the crimp tool former. If the terminal wings are wider than the crimp tool former, remove the terminal and bend the terminal wings in slightly. 5. Place stripped wire into terminal. 6. Crimp the new terminal to the wire. If a jam occurs, press the emergency release to open applicator. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire perform the following procedure in order to replace Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. Page 5556 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert terminal into the appropriate terminal holder until it hits bottom and stops. The correct terminal holder is determined by the wire size. Also ensure that the terminals wings are pointing towards the former on the tool and the release locator. 5. Insert the stripped cable into the terminal. Insulation should be visible on both sides of the terminal insulation wings. 6. Compress the handles until the ratchet automatically releases. 7. Place the terminal into the appropriate cavity and assemble the connector. Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO-PACK 100W) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W connectors. These connectors are very similar but use different terminals and have some minor physical differences also. Page 7804 MOLEX CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. 2. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. Page 6671 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (BSK) BOSCH CONNECTORS (BSK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 3. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 4. Insert the J 38125-561 tool into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 5. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is Page 1885 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. JST Connectors JST CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, remove the connector from the component. Page 8667 5. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove TPA from the connector. 6. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Heated Oxygen Sensor Replacement - Bank 1 Sensor 1 Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Heated Oxygen Sensor Replacement - Bank 1 Sensor 1 Heated Oxygen Sensor Replacement - Bank 1 Sensor 1 Removal Procedure Notice: Refer to Heated Oxygen and Oxygen Sensor Notice. Notice: Refer to Excessive Force and Oxygen Sensor Notice. 1. Raise and suitably support the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Unscrew the heated oxygen sensor (HO2S) sensor from the catalytic converter. 3. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) retainer. 4. Disconnect the HO2S electrical connector (3). Installation Procedure Page 2482 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 3051 Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair Suction Screen Replacement Suction Screen Replacement Tools Required J44551 Suction Screen Kit Removal Procedure 1. Remove the A/C Compressor hose assembly from the A/C compressor. 2. Using the Universal Removal Tool J-44551-9 place the tip of the tool under the inside edge of the compression band of the suction screen and the cushioning fulcrum pad against the open end of the hose or manifold fitting. Important: Do not damage the end of the hose or manifold. 3. Pry upward on the band and move the tool around the diameter of the screen as necessary to remove the screen. Installation Procedure 1. Install suction screen. 2. Install the A/C Compressor hose assembly to the A/C compressor. Install suction screen. Page 293 Electronic Adjustable Pedals (EAP) Relay Page 6507 Important: Before installing the camshaft sensor assembly, apply a small amount of clean motor oil to the O-ring (6). 4. Install the camshaft position sensor assembly (4, 5, 6) in the front cover (7). Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 5. Install the camshaft position sensor mounting bolts. Tighten the camshaft position mounting bolts 25 N.m (18 lb ft). 6. Install the generator assembly. Page 8854 If a wire is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm, etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except coaxial. - Do not use the DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent American wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 1933 Oxygen Sensor: Connector Views Engine Controls Connector End Views Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Bank 1 Sensor 1 Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Bank 1 Sensor 2 Page 8321 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the DuraSeal splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of a connector. CPAs are used in all SIR System connectors and also in some connectors of other systems. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals of a connection. TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE CLIPS IMPORTANT: When making a splice in an area that may be exposed to moisture use a crimp and seal splice sleeve instead of a Splice Clip. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. Locations Parking Lamp Relay: Locations Fuse Block - Rear, Label Page 6940 6. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by pressing on the tang. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (SENSOR) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) tool into the cavity on the lower right hand face of the connector until the terminal release tang access panel slides over. Page 2367 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry one side of the nose piece up to the pre-stage position. When the nose piece is in the pre-staged position, the nose piece will be raised above the connector body the length of the step in the nose piece. 7. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry the other side of the piece to the pre-stage position. If the nose piece is higher than the first step in the nose piece, gently push down on the nose piece until it meets with resistance from the connector body, you should feel the nose piece click into position. Page 4630 4. Use a small flat-blade tool to slide the terminal position assurance (TPA) up one notch on both ends of the connector. The TPA is located underneath the wire dress cover. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 6911 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Ensure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the Terminal Removal Procedure. Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PULL TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL If the terminal is visibly damaged or is suspected of having a faulty connection, the terminal should be replaced. Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors: 1. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) device and/or the secondary lock. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component or separate the connectors for in-line connectors. 3. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device. 4. Insert the proper pick or removal tool into the front of the connector body. 5. IMPORTANT: On connectors with more than one terminal the service loop may not be large enough to remove the terminal and crimp on a new one. If the terminal wire does not have a large enough service loop for removal, cut the wire 5 cm (2 in) behind the connector before removal. Grasp the wire at the back of the connector body and gently push the terminal out the front of the connector body. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. If the wire needed to be cut in order to remove the terminal, gently push a small length of the same size wire through the back of the connector cavity until there is enough wire exposed in order to crimp on a new terminal. If the wire was not cut, cut the existing wire as close to the old terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 4. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. TERMINAL INSTALLATION 1. Align the terminal and pull the wire from the back of the connector in order to seat the terminal. 2. If necessary, cut the new wire to proper length and splice with existing circuit. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. 3. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply dielectric grease to the connector. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PUSH TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 4742 11. Remove the coolant recovery line from the radiator. 12. Remove the upper radiator to condenser bolts. 13. Lift upward on the condenser to remove from the radiator retaining tab. 14. Remove the radiator. Installation Procedure Page 6059 Utility/Van Zoning UTILITY/VAN ZONING Page 5981 Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. FCI Connectors FCI CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 4948 9. The illustration shows a cutaway view of the connector to aid the technician in releasing the terminal retainer. 10. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Terminal Position Assurance Locks TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Tyco/Amp Connectors (CM 42-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (CM 42-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the connector body and pull the CPA out. The CPA is on the wire harness side of connector. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 8940 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Kostal Connectors KOSTAL CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 5805 If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200 DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J 39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected. IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J 39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and maximum (MAX) values measured. 1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of a suspected circuit to the other. 2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J 39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep). IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value in order to record the full change. 5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling the connections or the wiring, test driving, or performing other operations. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions. 6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9. Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist. Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections TESTING FOR INTERMITTENT CONDITIONS AND POOR CONNECTIONS TOOLS REQUIRED - J 35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit - J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit When the condition is not currently present, but is indicated in DTC history, the cause may be intermittent. An intermittent may also be the cause when there is a customer complaint, but the symptom cannot be duplicated. Refer to the Symptom Table of the system that is suspect of causing the condition before trying to locate an intermittent condition. Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the following items: Wiring broken inside the insulation - Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector - Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself, and corrosion in the wire to terminal contact area, etc. - Pierced or damaged insulation can allow moisture to enter the wiring causing corrosion. The conductor can corrode inside the insulation, with little visible evidence. Look for swollen and stiff sections of wire in the suspect circuits. - Wiring which has been pinched, cut, or its insulation rubbed through may cause an intermittent open or short as the bare area touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle. - Wiring that comes in contact with hot or exhaust components - Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required, in order to verify the customer concern. - Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. - Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis and Vehicle Data Recorder operation. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any inline connectors before replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation. Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination, usually in the underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit. Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper adapter. Always use the J 35616 when probing connectors. Other causes of terminal deformation are improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT IN BUSSED ELECTRICAL CENTERS (BEC) Page 2217 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. 4. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front of the connector. Page 3994 Step 7 - Step 19 Step 20 Page 6333 The first connector design of the Micro-Pack 100W (1) has a white connector interface that holds the terminals. The second design of the Micro-Pack 100W (2) has a gray interface to hold the terminals. Also, the first design has terminal cavities that are further apart (3 mm centerline) and offset from the other row of terminal cavities in the connector. The second design has terminals cavities that are closer together (2.54 mm centerline) and aligned vertically. One other way to identify the second design is the thin strip of material that runs along the outside of the cavities. IMPORTANT: There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W terminals which are very similar. Ensure that you have the correct terminal before crimping the new terminal to the wire. The first design connector uses the longer terminal (1) that has a raised area in front of the recess in the terminal. The second design connector uses the shorter terminal without the raised area. Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro-Pack 100W connectors. Some Micro-Pack 100W connector disassembly procedures will vary. Use this procedure as a guide. 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 6178 Page 8545 2. Locate the nose piece locking tabs that are positioned on the side of the connector nose piece. The connector nose piece acts as a terminal positive assurance (TPA) and may be referred to as such. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to push in one of the locking tabs while gently pulling on the same side of the nose piece. 4. Repeat the procedure for the other locking tab and remove the nose piece. 5. Remove the wire dress cover. The following is a general procedure for wire dress cover removal. Use this procedure as a guide, some dress cover removal procedures may vary. 6. Use fingers to squeeze the 2 locking legs of the cover. Page 7913 Remove all rust from the ground terminal, the cylinder head and the retaining nut or bolt. Position the main engine wiring harness ground terminal and install the nut or bolt. Tighten: Tighten the retaining nut or bolt to 16 N.m (12 lb ft). Apply some type of electrical moisture sealant to protect the harness terminal from further corrosion. Disclaimer Page 5324 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Ensure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the Terminal Removal Procedure. Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PULL TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL If the terminal is visibly damaged or is suspected of having a faulty connection, the terminal should be replaced. Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors: 1. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) device and/or the secondary lock. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component or separate the connectors for in-line connectors. 3. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device. 4. Insert the proper pick or removal tool into the front of the connector body. 5. IMPORTANT: On connectors with more than one terminal the service loop may not be large enough to remove the terminal and crimp on a new one. If the terminal wire does not have a large enough service loop for removal, cut the wire 5 cm (2 in) behind the connector before removal. Grasp the wire at the back of the connector body and gently push the terminal out the front of the connector body. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. If the wire needed to be cut in order to remove the terminal, gently push a small length of the same size wire through the back of the connector cavity until there is enough wire exposed in order to crimp on a new terminal. If the wire was not cut, cut the existing wire as close to the old terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 4. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. TERMINAL INSTALLATION 1. Align the terminal and pull the wire from the back of the connector in order to seat the terminal. 2. If necessary, cut the new wire to proper length and splice with existing circuit. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. 3. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply dielectric grease to the connector. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PUSH TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Locations Fuel Pump Relay: Locations Fuse Block - Underhood (5.3L/6.0L), Label Page 8435 7. The illustration above identifies the entry canal where the terminal release tool will be inserted, and the terminal cavity. - Terminal (1) - Entry Canal (2) 8. Insert the J-38125-553 (15315247) tool into the entry canal and pry up on the terminal retainer. The terminal retainer is a small plastic piece on the top of the terminal. The terminal retainer must be held up while the terminal is pulled out of the connector. Page 6205 IMPORTANT: Ensure that the dress cover and connector body are both in the released position before reassembling. Failure to do so may cause damage to the connector and component. Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (0.64) BOSCH CONNECTORS (0.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While pressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock until the lever is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Pull the rubber boot that covers the wires back to expose the end of the connector dress cover. 4. Place the connector locking lever in the center of the connector. 5. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs that are on the wire end of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover and connector body and pry up. Page 6752 Page 4465 Page 3244 Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. For connectors with a bolt in the dress cover, turn the bolt counterclockwise to remove the connector from the component. 2. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. Page 7823 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert a small flat-blade tool in the slot below the front loaded terminal position assurance (TPA) and pry up. 3. Remove the TPA by pulling it out of the connector. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-553 (GM P/N 15315247) on a slight upward angle into the cavity below the terminal to be removed. Ensure that the pointed on the end of the tool is facing the bottom of the terminal and it stays in contact with the terminal until it stops on the plastic terminal retainer. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 5196 4. Use a small flat-blade tool to slide the terminal position assurance (TPA) up one notch on both ends of the connector. The TPA is located underneath the wire dress cover. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 6937 7. Pressing the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool in the release cavity of the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and crimper in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (DOOR MODULE) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Side view of connector. View of top of connector. 1. Locate the assist lever and lock on the top of the connector. Page 5242 US English/Metric Conversion US English/Metric Conversion Page 4813 pulling it through. This will prevent damage to the internal seals of the connector. Once the terminal is pushed out of the connector, cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible and pull the wire through the connector. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE The Micro-Pack 100W connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool was developed to crimp Micro-Pack 100W terminals. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 2. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert the terminal into the crimp tool until the core wings are flush with the anvil on the crimp tool. Be sure that the wings are pointed toward the crimp tool former and release the spring locator. The locator will hold the terminal in place. Inspect the alignment of the terminal wings with the crimp tool former. If the terminal wings are wider than the crimp tool former, remove the terminal and bend the terminal wings in slightly. 5. Place stripped wire into terminal. 6. Crimp the new terminal to the wire. If a jam occurs, press the emergency release to open applicator. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire perform the following procedure in order to replace Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. Page 1130 7. Wrap electrical tape around the connection as shown. 8. Route the engine coolant heater cord and extension cord behind the alternator and adjacent to the engine coolant crossover pipe as shown. 9. Continue to route the extension cord to the exit location desired by the customer as shown. 10. Review the routing of the coolant heater cord and extension cord to verify that it does not touch any sharp edges that could damage it. 11. Secure the engine coolant heater cord and the extension cord with tie straps as needed. 12. Resecure any of the original clips that retained the engine coolant heater cord to the vehicle that were released to provide length. Part Information The extension cord may be obtained at any of the following outlets: - Lowes* - Home Depot* - Canada: Acklands-Grainger* (www.acklandsgrainger.com), Catalogue Part Number: CWRSJTOW3C14-10 USA: Cords should bear the UL symbol. Canada: Cords should bear the ULc symbol or CSA approval. *We believe these sources and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume any responsibility for the products or material from these firms or for any such items that may be available from other sources. Page 9018 View of connector in released position. 4. Disconnect the connector from the component. 5. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Release the rear lower half of the wiredress cover. Page 3756 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) and slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. Page 5073 Body Control Module: Diagrams Body Control Module (BCM) C3 Body Control Module (BCM) C3 Page 7542 Release the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the blue locking tabs on both ends of the connector. Gently slide the TPA up to the released position on both ends. 6. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-13A (GM P/N 12031876-1) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. Page 8860 If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the DuraSeal splice sleeves. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: - Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. - Do not use the crimp and DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 to crimp DuraSeal splice sleeve. In order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 8844 2. Use a small flat-bladed tool to release the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting the tool in the small recess on the side of the connector and pushing up until the TPA releases from the connector body. The TPA should raise just slightly. Do not try to remove the TPA. IMPORTANT: The TPA on this connector cannot be removed unless the terminals are removed first. The TPA will come out of the connector body, but only slightly. When the TPA is slightly raised the terminals can be removed. Using excessive force to remove the TPA with the terminals still in the connector will damage the connector. 3. Repeat the process for the other side of the connector. 4. Ensure that the TPA is in the proper position to remove the terminals. Page 8928 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Ensure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the Terminal Removal Procedure. Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PULL TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL If the terminal is visibly damaged or is suspected of having a faulty connection, the terminal should be replaced. Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors: 1. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) device and/or the secondary lock. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component or separate the connectors for in-line connectors. 3. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device. 4. Insert the proper pick or removal tool into the front of the connector body. 5. IMPORTANT: On connectors with more than one terminal the service loop may not be large enough to remove the terminal and crimp on a new one. If the terminal wire does not have a large enough service loop for removal, cut the wire 5 cm (2 in) behind the connector before removal. Grasp the wire at the back of the connector body and gently push the terminal out the front of the connector body. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. If the wire needed to be cut in order to remove the terminal, gently push a small length of the same size wire through the back of the connector cavity until there is enough wire exposed in order to crimp on a new terminal. If the wire was not cut, cut the existing wire as close to the old terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 4. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. TERMINAL INSTALLATION 1. Align the terminal and pull the wire from the back of the connector in order to seat the terminal. 2. If necessary, cut the new wire to proper length and splice with existing circuit. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. 3. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply dielectric grease to the connector. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PUSH TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Locations Camshaft Position Sensor: Locations Engine Controls Component Views Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor 1 - Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor 2 - C110 Page 1715 difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Bosch Connectors (ECM) BOSCH CONNECTORS (ECM) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the assist lever on the top of the connector. Move the assist lever to the forward position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 1429 Refer to the following table as a guide in selecting the correct test adapter for front probing connectors: Backprobe IMPORTANT: Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures. - Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector. - Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large of a test probe. - After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected, test for proper terminal contact. Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the connector. Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure SCAN TOOL SNAPSHOT PROCEDURE Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used Page 7941 Disclaimer Engine - MIL ON P0116/P1400 Set In Very Cold Temps Engine Block Heater: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - MIL ON P0116/P1400 Set In Very Cold Temps TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 10-06-04-008A Date: January 24, 2011 Subject: Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) Illuminated at Very Cold Ambient Temperatures When Using Engine Coolant Heater, DTC P0116 and/or P1400 Set (Relocate Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor and Engine Coolant Heater Cord) Models: 2006-2007 Buick Rainier 2009 Buick LaCrosse Super, Allure Super (Canada Only) 2006-2010 Cadillac Escalade 2006-2007 Chevrolet Monte Carlo 2006-2009 Chevrolet Impala SS, TrailBlazer 2006-2010 Chevrolet Avalanche, Express, Silverado Tahoe 2006-2009 GMC Envoy 2006-2010 GMC Savana, Sierra, Yukon 2006-2008 Pontiac Grand Prix 2006-2009 Saab 9-7X Equipped with V8 Engine RPO LC9, LH6, LH8, LH9, L76, LS2, LS4, LFA, LZ1, L92, L94, L9H or L20, L96, LMF, LMG, LY2, LY5, LY6 Please Refer to GMVIS Attention: To properly correct this condition, you must follow both of the procedures to relocate the ECT sensor and the engine coolant heater cord. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add cast iron block engine RPOs and to update the Warranty Information coverage period. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 10-06-04-008 (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). Condition Some customers may comment that the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) illuminates after starting the vehicle when they were using the engine coolant heater in very cold ambient temperatures. This usually occurs in a range of -23 to -40°C (-10 to -40°F) or colder. The technician may observe on a scan tool DTC P0116 and/or P1400 set as Current or in History. Cause This condition may be caused by the engine control module (ECM) determining that the ignition OFF time requirement has been met at start-up and interpreting the temperature difference between the engine coolant temperature (ECT) sensor and the intake air temperature (IAT) sensor as being outside of a calibrated range. Correction Important DO NOT replace the ECM for this condition. Relocating the ECT Sensor 1. Turn ON the ignition with the engine OFF. 2. Perform the diagnostic system check - vehicle. Refer to Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle in SI. ‹› If DTC P0116 and/or P1400 are set and the customer WAS using the engine coolant heater, proceed to Step 3. ‹› If DTC P0116 and/or P1400 are set and the customer WAS NOT using the engine coolant heater, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle in SI. 3. Turn OFF the ignition. Warning To avoid being burned, do not remove the radiator cap or surge tank cap while the engine is hot. The cooling system will release scalding fluid and steam Page 978 4. If the ECM was previously removed from the ECM/TCM bracket (2), install the ECM (3). Refer to Engine Control Module Replacement for the 5.3L engine. 5. Insert the TCM (1) into the retaining slot of the ECM/TCM bracket (2). 6. Secure the TCM (2) to the ECM/TCM mounting bracket ensuring the TCM retaining tab (1) is fully engaged. Page 1398 11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the solder equipment. 12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. 13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to cover the first piece of tape. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE SLEEVES TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit IMPORTANT: Use only dura seal splice sleeves. Other splice sleeves may not protect the splice from moisture or provide a good electrical connection. Use duraseal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. Use duraseal splice sleeves where there is special requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire using duraseal splice sleeves. Page 4560 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the DuraSeal splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of a connector. CPAs are used in all SIR System connectors and also in some connectors of other systems. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals of a connection. TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE CLIPS IMPORTANT: When making a splice in an area that may be exposed to moisture use a crimp and seal splice sleeve instead of a Splice Clip. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. Diagram Information and Instructions Knock Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions Electrical Symbols Page 7029 IMPORTANT: Ensure that the dress cover and connector body are both in the released position before reassembling. Failure to do so may cause damage to the connector and component. Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (0.64) BOSCH CONNECTORS (0.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While pressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock until the lever is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Pull the rubber boot that covers the wires back to expose the end of the connector dress cover. 4. Place the connector locking lever in the center of the connector. 5. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs that are on the wire end of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover and connector body and pry up. Page 1779 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Start in the middle and gradually move the heat barrel to the open ends of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Heated Oxygen Sensor Wiring Repairs HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being obstructed. If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. - Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks, etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire. - Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance. - To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector. Brakes - ABS Lamp ON/DTC's C0265/C0201/U1041 Set Electronic Brake Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - ABS Lamp ON/DTC's C0265/C0201/U1041 Set TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 04-05-25-002E Date: March 11, 2009 Subject: ABS Light On, DTCs C0265, C0201, U1041 Set and/or Loss of Communication with Brake Module (Reground EBCM Ground) Models Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add step 2 to the procedure and update the Parts and Warranty Information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 04-05-25-002D (Section 05 - Brakes). Condition Some customers may comment that the ABS light is on. Upon further inspection, DTCs C0265 and C0201 may be set in the brake module. It is also possible for DTC U1041 to set in other modules. There may also be a loss of communication with the brake module. Cause A poor connection at the EBCM ground is causing unnecessary replacement of brake modules. Important: The EBCM ground is different for each application. Refer to the list below for the proper ground reference: ^ Midsize Utilities = Ground 304 ^ SSR = Ground 400 ^ Fullsize Trucks and Utilities = Ground 110 Correction Important: Do not replace the brake module to correct this condition. Perform the following repair before further diagnosis of the EBCM. Perform the following steps to improve the connection of the EBCM Ground: 1. Remove the EBCM Ground. The EBCM Ground is located on the frame beneath the driver's side door. If multiple grounds are found in this location, the EBCM ground can be identified as the heavy (12-gauge) wire. 2. If the original fastener has a welded on nut, remove the nut from the frame, and if required, enlarge the bolt hole to accommodate the new bolt and nut. 3. Clean the area, front and back, using a tool such as a *3M(TM) Scotch-Brite Roloc disc or equivalent. Page 8227 Page 3308 2. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully push the terminal position assurance (TPA) towards the face of the connector on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA is fragile and may break if not done carefully. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. 3. Use the J 38125-215 tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 1176 Discharge Air Temperature Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair Air Temperature Sensor Replacement - Lower Left Side Air Temperature Sensor Replacement - Lower Left Side Removal Procedure 1. Remove the I/P assembly. 2. Disconnect the electrical connector from the air temperature sensor-lower left (2). 3. Remove the air temperature sensor-lower left. Installation Procedure 1. Install the air temperature sensor-lower left (2). 2. Connect the electrical connector to the air temperature sensor-lower left. 3. Install the I/P assembly. Page 4828 4. Slide the dress cover forward and off of the connector. 5. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front and rear of the connector. Page 1504 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Start in the middle and gradually move the heat barrel to the open ends of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Heated Oxygen Sensor Wiring Repairs HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being obstructed. If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. - Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks, etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire. - Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance. - To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector. Page 2506 Open the harness by removing any tape. 2. Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. 3. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 4. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent american wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 5. Slide a section of high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing down the length of wire to be spliced. Ensure that the shrink tubing will not interfere with the splice procedure. 6. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 7. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. 8. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 9. Insert the wire into the DuraSeal splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 10. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Page 7562 5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape. Seat Belt Schematic Icons Seat Belt Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons Page 784 Engine Control Module: Description and Operation Engine Control Module Description The powertrain has electronic controls to reduce exhaust emissions while maintaining excellent driveability and fuel economy. The engine control module (ECM) is the control center of this system. The ECM monitors numerous engine and vehicle functions. The ECM constantly monitors the information from various sensors and other inputs, and controls the systems that affect vehicle performance and emissions. The ECM also performs the diagnostic tests on various parts of the system. The ECM can recognize operational problems and alert the driver via the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL). When the ECM detects a malfunction, the ECM stores a diagnostic trouble code (DTC). The problem area is identified by the particular DTC that is set. The control module supplies a buffered voltage to various sensors and switches. Review the components and wiring diagrams in order to determine which systems are controlled by the ECM. Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) Operation The malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) is located in the instrument panel cluster. The MIL will display as either SERVICE ENGINE SOON or one of the following symbols when commanded ON: The MIL indicates that an emissions related fault has occurred and vehicle service is required. The following is a list of the modes of operation for the MIL: * The MIL illuminates when the ignition is turned ON, with the engine OFF. This is a bulb test to ensure the MIL is able to illuminate. * The MIL turns OFF after the engine is started if a diagnostic fault is not present. * The MIL remains illuminated after the engine is started if the control module detects a fault. A diagnostic trouble code (DTC) is stored any time the control module illuminates the MIL due to an emissions related fault. The MIL turns OFF after three consecutive ignition cycles in which a Test Passed has been reported for the diagnostic test that originally caused the MIL to illuminate. * The MIL flashes if the control module detects a misfire condition which could damage the catalytic converter. * When the MIL is illuminated and the engine stalls, the MIL will remain illuminated as long as the ignition is ON. * When the MIL is not illuminated and the engine stalls, the MIL will not illuminate until the ignition is cycled OFF and then ON. Page 6578 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. 4. Remove the dress cover by using a flat bladed tool to release the dress cover locking tabs and lift up on the dress cover. 5. Cut the tie wrap that holds the wires to the connector body. Diagrams Steering Angle Sensor: Diagrams Antilock Brake System Connector End Views Steering Wheel Speed/Position Sensor Steering Wheel Speed/Position Sensor Steering Wheel Speed/Position Sensor Diagram Information and Instructions Oxygen Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions Electrical Symbols Page 4811 2. Locate the nose piece locking tabs that are positioned on the side of the connector nose piece. The connector nose piece acts as a terminal positive assurance (TPA) and may be referred to as such. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to push in one of the locking tabs while gently pulling on the same side of the nose piece. 4. Repeat the procedure for the other locking tab and remove the nose piece. 5. Remove the wire dress cover. The following is a general procedure for wire dress cover removal. Use this procedure as a guide, some dress cover removal procedures may vary. 6. Use fingers to squeeze the 2 locking legs of the cover. Page 2366 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. 4. Remove the dress cover by using a flat bladed tool to release the dress cover locking tabs and lift up on the dress cover. 5. Cut the tie wrap that holds the wires to the connector body. Page 1366 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry one side of the nose piece up to the pre-stage position. When the nose piece is in the pre-staged position, the nose piece will be raised above the connector body the length of the step in the nose piece. 7. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry the other side of the piece to the pre-stage position. If the nose piece is higher than the first step in the nose piece, gently push down on the nose piece until it meets with resistance from the connector body, you should feel the nose piece click into position. Page 338 Electronic Brake Control Module: Service and Repair Electronic Brake Control Module Replacement Page 4965 If a wire is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm, etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except coaxial. - Do not use the DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent American wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 2789 Transmission Speed Sensor: Adjustments Range Selector Lever Cable Adjustment Adjustment Procedure 1. Ensure that the range selector cable is not restricted. 2. Ensure that the floor shift control is in the PARK position. 3. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 4. Disconnect the range selector cable (4) from the range selector lever ball stud (6). 5. Ensure that the range selector lever is in the mechanical PARK position. (Rotate the range selector lever fully clockwise.) 6. Release the locking tab (1). 7. Slide the secondary lock cover (1) to the side. Page 7507 7. Apply pressure and gently rock the cover until one locking leg is unseated. 8. Continue to apply pressure and rock the cover until the second locking leg is unseated. Repeat procedure for the other side of the dress cover and remove the cover. 9. Use J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) to gently lift the terminal retaining tab while gently pulling the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 10. If the terminal is severely bent or damaged, it may be possible on some connectors to push the wire out of the front of the connector instead of Page 2380 2. Use a small flat-bladed tool to release the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting the tool in the small recess on the side of the connector and pushing up until the TPA releases from the connector body. The TPA should raise just slightly. Do not try to remove the TPA. IMPORTANT: The TPA on this connector cannot be removed unless the terminals are removed first. The TPA will come out of the connector body, but only slightly. When the TPA is slightly raised the terminals can be removed. Using excessive force to remove the TPA with the terminals still in the connector will damage the connector. 3. Repeat the process for the other side of the connector. 4. Ensure that the TPA is in the proper position to remove the terminals. Page 3810 Valve Deactivation Solenoid: Connector Views Engine Controls Connector End Views Valve Lifter Oil Manifold (VLOM) Assembly Page 977 10. Remove the ECM/TCM bracket retaining bolts (2). 11. Remove the ECM/TCM bracket (1) from the vehicle frame. Installation Procedure 1. If the ECM/TCM bracket (1) was previously removed, install the ECM/TCM bracket (1) to the vehicle frame. 2. Install the ECM/TCM bracket retaining bolts (2). Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 3. Tighten the ECM/TCM bracket bolts. Tighten the bolts to 10 N.m (89 lb in). Page 4483 - A control module from another vehicle is installed. - Revised software/calibration files have been released for this vehicle. - IMPORTANT: DO NOT re-program the control module with the SAME software/calibration files that are already present in the control module. This is not an effective repair for any type of concern. Verify that the control module contains the correct software/calibration. If incorrect programming is found, reprogram the control module with the most current software/calibration. Refer to Control Module References for replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Testing for Short to Ground TESTING FOR SHORT TO GROUND NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 4. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit. With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is a short to ground in the circuit. Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2. Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). - When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. - If the DMM does not display voltage 4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is shorted. Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A DIGITAL MULTIMETER NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the powertrain control module (PCM), should only be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200 Digital Multimeter (DMM). The J 39200 instruction manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminage even though voltage is present. The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity. IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading. Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the measurement. Page 1223 Parking Brake Warning Switch: Diagrams Hydraulic Brake Connector End Views Park Brake Switch Page 6617 Page 1343 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert terminal into the appropriate terminal holder until it hits bottom and stops. The correct terminal holder is determined by the wire size. Also ensure that the terminals wings are pointing towards the former on the tool and the release locator. 5. Insert the stripped cable into the terminal. Insulation should be visible on both sides of the terminal insulation wings. 6. Compress the handles until the ratchet automatically releases. 7. Place the terminal into the appropriate cavity and assemble the connector. Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO-PACK 100W) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W connectors. These connectors are very similar but use different terminals and have some minor physical differences also. Page 3306 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert a small flat-blade tool in the slot below the front loaded terminal position assurance (TPA) and pry up. 3. Remove the TPA by pulling it out of the connector. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-553 (GM P/N 15315247) on a slight upward angle into the cavity below the terminal to be removed. Ensure that the pointed on the end of the tool is facing the bottom of the terminal and it stays in contact with the terminal until it stops on the plastic terminal retainer. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 2025 7. The illustration above identifies the entry canal where the terminal release tool will be inserted, and the terminal cavity. - Terminal (1) - Entry Canal (2) 8. Insert the J-38125-553 (15315247) tool into the entry canal and pry up on the terminal retainer. The terminal retainer is a small plastic piece on the top of the terminal. The terminal retainer must be held up while the terminal is pulled out of the connector. Page 7391 2. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 6092 View of a typical Micro 64 connector. Depress the lock and pull the lever over and past the lock. Cooling System - Inspecting Radiator/Heater Hose Clamps Hose Clamp: Technical Service Bulletins Cooling System - Inspecting Radiator/Heater Hose Clamps INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 06-06-02-014B Date: June 13, 2008 Subject: Inspecting Radiator and Heater Hose Clamps and Seals for Leaks During Pre-Delivery Inspection (PDI) Models: 2007 Buick Rainier 2007-2009 Chevrolet TrailBlazer, TrailBlazer SS 2007-2009 GMC Envoy 2007-2009 Saab 9-7X Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2009 model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 06-06-02-014A (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). The purpose of this bulletin is to inform dealers of required inspection of underhood and under vehicle radiator and heater hose clamps and seals for leaks and/or seepage during pre-delivery inspection (PDI). Field feedback indicates that some customers may notice engine coolant leaks shortly after delivery, which may result in an immediate decline of customer satisfaction with their new vehicle purchase. When performing a PDI on a vehicle listed in the models affected above, pay specific attention to the effectiveness of the engine coolant hose seal locations. Reposition/reclamp or replace the clamp to effect a proper system seal prior to customer delivery. Locations to Inspect During PDI Dealership personnel should examine the following locations closely during PDI (4.2L LL8 application shown in graphics below; refer to SI for specific information on 5.3L LH6 and 6.0L LS2):L LH6 and 6.0L LS2): 1. Radiator inlet hose (upper hose) to radiator (1). 2. Radiator inlet hose (upper hose) to engine (2). Page 681 vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide variety of actions, including: - Wiggling the harness - Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting - Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector - Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation - Relocating a harness or wires All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. Another option is, with the component commanded ON and OFF by the scan tool, move related connectors and wiring and observe the component operation. With the engine running, move related connectors and wiring while monitoring engine operation. If harness or connector movement affects the data displayed, component/system operation, or engine operation, inspect and repair the harness/connections as necessary. You may need to load the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these cases you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide good results as well. There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions, along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the circuit to these kinds of conditions. SALT WATER SPRAY Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture. Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5 percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously. HIGH TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070. Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault condition. The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis. This option does not allow for the same control, however. LOW TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect. If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to -18°C (0°F) from one end and +71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized cooling needs. Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or components in an effort to duplicate the concern. DUPLICATING FAILURE CONDITIONS - If none of the previous tests are successful, attempt to duplicate and/or capture the failure conditions. Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, where applicable, contains the conditions that were present when the DTC set. 1. Review and record Freeze Frame/Failure Records data. 2. Clear the DTCs using the scan tool. 3. Turn the key to OFF and wait 15 seconds. 4. Operate the vehicle under the same conditions that were noted in Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, as closely as possible. The vehicle must also be operating within the Conditions for Running the DTC. Refer to Conditions for Running the DTC in the supporting text if a DTC is being diagnosed. 5. Monitor DTC Status for the DTC being tested. The scan tool will indicate Ran, when the enabling conditions have been satisfied long enough for the DTC to run. The scan tool will also indicate whether the DTC passed or failed. - An alternate method is to drive the vehicle with the DMM connected to a suspected circuit. An abnormal reading on the DMM when the concern occurs, may help you locate the concern. Measuring Frequency Page 5989 4. Slide the dress cover forward and off of the connector. 5. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front and rear of the connector. Page 2648 5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape. Seat Belt Schematic Icons Seat Belt Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons Page 7765 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (BSK) BOSCH CONNECTORS (BSK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 3. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 4. Insert the J 38125-561 tool into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 5. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is Page 5656 Page 7604 Checking Aftermarket Accessories CHECKING AFTERMARKET ACCESSORIES Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits: - CAUTION: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol. - NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice. OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol. Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the cause of the problems. Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include: Power feeds connected to points other than the battery - Antenna location - Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring - Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line - Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories. Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions INDUCING INTERMITTENT FAULT CONDITIONS TOOLS REQUIRED J 25070 Heat Gun Many intermittent open or shorted circuits are affected by harness/connector movement that is caused by vibration, engine torque, bumps/rough pavement, etc. In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness if the malfunction appears to be Page 4937 View of typical connector. View of connector in released position. 1. Locate the assist lever at the back of the connector. Move the assist lever to the rear position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the dress cover. Page 5079 Body Control Module: Service and Repair Body Control Module Replacement BODY CONTROL MODULE REPLACEMENT REMOVAL PROCEDURE IMPORTANT: The ignition switch should be in the OFF position when connecting or disconnecting the connectors to the body control module (BCM). - Always disconnect the 40-way body wiring extension FIRST, the 32-way tan connector SECOND and the 24-way gray electrical connector LAST. - Always connect the 24-way gray electrical connector FIRST, the 32-way tan connector SECOND and the 40-way body wiring extension LAST. - The BCM can set DTCs with the ignition switch in the OFF position. The BCM has battery run down protection for the courtesy lamp circuit. The BCM battery run down protection cannot detect shorts on inputs or other circuits which the BCM does not control. Use the scan tool in order to activate the POWER DOWN NOW mode. Use the POWER DOWN NOW mode in order to check for current draws on circuits that are not controlled by the BCM, or controlled by the battery run down protection system. - Do not touch the exposed electrical contacts of the body wiring extension. Do not open the BCM housing. The module does not have any serviceable components. The module may be replaced only as an assembly. 1. CAUTION: Refer to Battery Disconnect Caution. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. If replacing the BCM on a Chevrolet TrailBlazer EXT or GMC Envoy XL, remove the left second row seat. 3. If replacing the BCM on a Chevrolet TrailBlazer or GMC Envoy, position the left hand second seat to a cargo position. 4. Remove the rear electrical center cover. 5. Press down and hold the locking tab (1). 6. Disengage the sliding latch retaining the BCM to the rear electrical center.Slide the latch inboard until fully extended, approximately 40 mm (1.6 in). 7. Disconnect the 40-way body wiring extension (1) from the BCM. Locations Underhood Lamp Switch: Locations Liftgate Page 5290 IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals. Front probe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the connector. IMPORTANT: When probing female 0.64 terminals, it is important to use the correct adapter. There have been some revisions to the test adapter for 0.64 terminals. The proper adapter for 0.64 terminals is the J 35616-64B which has a gold terminal and a black wire between the base and tip. Failure to use the proper test adapter may result in damage to the terminal being tested and improper diagnosis. NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Page 7687 If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs SIR/SRS WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS, and the wiring components, such as connectors and terminals. IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system terminals. Use either an SIR/SRS pigtail or a terminated lead from the SIR Repair Kit Tray. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves, in order to repair the SIR/SRS wiring - A special crimping tool - A heat torch - An instruction manual The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides the necessary low resistance contact integrity for these sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors SIR/SRS CONNECTOR REPAIR (PLASTIC BODY AND TERMINAL METAL PIN) The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made with a special plating. This plating provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. Use the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit for repairing SIR/SRS terminals and connectors. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the repair kit. The J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit contains: Various terminated leads for sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) terminal replacement - Various connector positive assurance (CPA) locks for SIR/SRS connectors - Base of steering column pigtail connectors part number 12085514 - Yellow vinyl electrical tape Pigtail repair packs are available for SIR/SRS connectors with eight or less terminals. Only the connector body is available for connectors with more than eight terminals. The terminated leads in the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit can be used to replace damaged terminals when replacing the connector body. SIR/SRS COMPONENT WIRE PIGTAIL REPAIR IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails. A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device, not by a connector. If a wiring pigtail is damaged, you must replace the entire component, with pigtail. The inflatable restraint steering wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component. SIR/SRS WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 1872 The first connector design of the Micro-Pack 100W (1) has a white connector interface that holds the terminals. The second design of the Micro-Pack 100W (2) has a gray interface to hold the terminals. Also, the first design has terminal cavities that are further apart (3 mm centerline) and offset from the other row of terminal cavities in the connector. The second design has terminals cavities that are closer together (2.54 mm centerline) and aligned vertically. One other way to identify the second design is the thin strip of material that runs along the outside of the cavities. IMPORTANT: There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W terminals which are very similar. Ensure that you have the correct terminal before crimping the new terminal to the wire. The first design connector uses the longer terminal (1) that has a raised area in front of the recess in the terminal. The second design connector uses the shorter terminal without the raised area. Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro-Pack 100W connectors. Some Micro-Pack 100W connector disassembly procedures will vary. Use this procedure as a guide. 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 549 If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs SIR/SRS WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS, and the wiring components, such as connectors and terminals. IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system terminals. Use either an SIR/SRS pigtail or a terminated lead from the SIR Repair Kit Tray. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves, in order to repair the SIR/SRS wiring - A special crimping tool - A heat torch - An instruction manual The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides the necessary low resistance contact integrity for these sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors SIR/SRS CONNECTOR REPAIR (PLASTIC BODY AND TERMINAL METAL PIN) The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made with a special plating. This plating provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. Use the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit for repairing SIR/SRS terminals and connectors. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the repair kit. The J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit contains: Various terminated leads for sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) terminal replacement - Various connector positive assurance (CPA) locks for SIR/SRS connectors - Base of steering column pigtail connectors part number 12085514 - Yellow vinyl electrical tape Pigtail repair packs are available for SIR/SRS connectors with eight or less terminals. Only the connector body is available for connectors with more than eight terminals. The terminated leads in the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit can be used to replace damaged terminals when replacing the connector body. SIR/SRS COMPONENT WIRE PIGTAIL REPAIR IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails. A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device, not by a connector. If a wiring pigtail is damaged, you must replace the entire component, with pigtail. The inflatable restraint steering wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component. SIR/SRS WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 1426 vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide variety of actions, including: - Wiggling the harness - Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting - Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector - Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation - Relocating a harness or wires All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. Another option is, with the component commanded ON and OFF by the scan tool, move related connectors and wiring and observe the component operation. With the engine running, move related connectors and wiring while monitoring engine operation. If harness or connector movement affects the data displayed, component/system operation, or engine operation, inspect and repair the harness/connections as necessary. You may need to load the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these cases you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide good results as well. There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions, along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the circuit to these kinds of conditions. SALT WATER SPRAY Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture. Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5 percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously. HIGH TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070. Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault condition. The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis. This option does not allow for the same control, however. LOW TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect. If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to -18°C (0°F) from one end and +71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized cooling needs. Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or components in an effort to duplicate the concern. DUPLICATING FAILURE CONDITIONS - If none of the previous tests are successful, attempt to duplicate and/or capture the failure conditions. Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, where applicable, contains the conditions that were present when the DTC set. 1. Review and record Freeze Frame/Failure Records data. 2. Clear the DTCs using the scan tool. 3. Turn the key to OFF and wait 15 seconds. 4. Operate the vehicle under the same conditions that were noted in Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, as closely as possible. The vehicle must also be operating within the Conditions for Running the DTC. Refer to Conditions for Running the DTC in the supporting text if a DTC is being diagnosed. 5. Monitor DTC Status for the DTC being tested. The scan tool will indicate Ran, when the enabling conditions have been satisfied long enough for the DTC to run. The scan tool will also indicate whether the DTC passed or failed. - An alternate method is to drive the vehicle with the DMM connected to a suspected circuit. An abnormal reading on the DMM when the concern occurs, may help you locate the concern. Measuring Frequency Engine - Low Oil Lamp ON/Oil Leaks Oil Pressure Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Low Oil Lamp ON/Oil Leaks TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 07-06-01-004A Date: November 25, 2008 Subject: All Vortec(R) GEN IV V8 Engines - LY2 LS4 LC9 LH6 LMG LY5 LS2 L76 LY6 L92 LS7, Low Oil Level Indicator Lamp On and/or Engine Oil Leak (Reseal Oil Pressure Sensor) Models Supercede: This bulletin is being updated to include a labor operation number for CTS-V and Corvette models. Please discard Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 07-06-01-004 (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System). Condition Some customers may comment on a low oil level indicator lamp on and/or engine oil leak. Upon further investigation, the technician may find that the oil leak is at the oil pressure sensor that is threaded into the valve lifter oil manifold (VLOM) assembly and/or engine valley cover. Correction If the engine oil leak was found to be at the engine oil pressure sensor, then remove the oil pressure sensor and reseal with a pipe sealant with Teflon or equivalent, P/N 12346004 (in Canada, P/N 10953480). Refer to Engine Oil Pressure Sensor and/or Switch Replacement in SI. Parts Information Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models) Page 6871 Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids Arrows and Symbols Arrows and Symbols This Service Data uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations. Arrows and Symbols 1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow Basic Knowledge Required GENERAL ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures contained in the service manual. You should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current (amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram, as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. Decimal and Metric Equivalents Decimal and Metric Equivalents Page 3707 Page 3412 9. The illustration shows a cutaway view of the connector to aid the technician in releasing the terminal retainer. 10. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Terminal Position Assurance Locks TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Tyco/Amp Connectors (CM 42-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (CM 42-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the connector body and pull the CPA out. The CPA is on the wire harness side of connector. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 5558 2. Locate the nose piece locking tabs that are positioned on the side of the connector nose piece. The connector nose piece acts as a terminal positive assurance (TPA) and may be referred to as such. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to push in one of the locking tabs while gently pulling on the same side of the nose piece. 4. Repeat the procedure for the other locking tab and remove the nose piece. 5. Remove the wire dress cover. The following is a general procedure for wire dress cover removal. Use this procedure as a guide, some dress cover removal procedures may vary. 6. Use fingers to squeeze the 2 locking legs of the cover. Page 3311 Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size. REPAIRING A FUSIBLE LINK IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient overload protection. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. Flat Wire Repairs FLAT WIRE REPAIRS NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced. GMLAN Wiring Repairs GMLAN WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The GM Local Area Network (GMLAN) System requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working on GMLAN connectors and terminals. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items in order to repair the GMLAN wiring: Dura Seal splice sleeves - A wire stripping tool - J 38125-8 Crimping Tool (GM P/N 12085115) - J 38125-5 Ultra Torch Special Tool (GM P/N 12085116) The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. - A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors GMLAN REPAIRS IMPORTANT: When making a repair to any GMLAN network, the original wire length after the repair must be the same length as before the repair. If the network is a twisted pair, the twist must be maintained after the repair is completed. GMLAN has 2 types of networks, low speed and high speed. Low speed GMLAN has a single wire and works at slow speeds. High speed GMLAN has 2 wires in a twisted pair and works at higher speeds. For more information on GMLAN, refer to Data Link Communications Description and Operation. GMLAN CONNECTOR TERMINAL REPAIR IMPORTANT: A service terminal can be used to replace damaged connector terminals for both high speed and low speed GMLAN systems. When making a connector terminal repair on a GMLAN high speed system with twisted pair wires, do not untwist the wires more than necessary to make the repair. The terminals in the GMLAN system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are available in the J-38125. If the individual terminals are damaged on any GMLAN connection, use the appropriate connector repair procedure in order to repair the terminal. GMLAN WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 4994 7. Wrap electrical tape around the connection as shown. 8. Route the engine coolant heater cord and extension cord behind the alternator and adjacent to the engine coolant crossover pipe as shown. 9. Continue to route the extension cord to the exit location desired by the customer as shown. 10. Review the routing of the coolant heater cord and extension cord to verify that it does not touch any sharp edges that could damage it. 11. Secure the engine coolant heater cord and the extension cord with tie straps as needed. 12. Resecure any of the original clips that retained the engine coolant heater cord to the vehicle that were released to provide length. Part Information The extension cord may be obtained at any of the following outlets: - Lowes* - Home Depot* - Canada: Acklands-Grainger* (www.acklandsgrainger.com), Catalogue Part Number: CWRSJTOW3C14-10 USA: Cords should bear the UL symbol. Canada: Cords should bear the ULc symbol or CSA approval. *We believe these sources and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume any responsibility for the products or material from these firms or for any such items that may be available from other sources. Page 5378 US English/Metric Conversion US English/Metric Conversion Page 6391 US English/Metric Conversion US English/Metric Conversion Page 6267 The engine harness may be repaired using the J-38125. High Temperature Wiring Repairs HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperatures, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time may use materials i.e. wires, connectors, and shielding that has a higher heat rating than typical wiring. When making a repair in a high temperature area observe the following: Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature to replace any damaged wire. - Replace any heat shielding that is removed. - Cover any DuraSeal splice sleeves with SCT1 shrink tubing (available in the J-38125 Terminal Repair kit). - After making a wiring repair, ensure that the location of the wiring is not moved closer to the heat source. IDENTIFYING HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperature, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time need special considerations when making wiring repairs. Areas that may be exposed to higher temperatures can be identified by heat resistant materials that are being used in those areas. These materials may include heat reflective tape, moon tape, and high temperature shrink tubing. Also conduit and other protective coverings may be used. Because conduit or similar coverings are used throughout the vehicle regardless of the temperature, it may be necessary for the technician to determine if an area is exposed to excessive heat before making a wiring repair. Obvious areas of consideration would be any area located near the exhaust manifolds, catalytic converter, and exhaust pipes. The J-38125 contains much of the material you will need to perform repairs on areas exposed to high heat. The kit contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves to crimp and seal connections - High temperature SCT1 shrink tubing to protect the splice sleeves - A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct crimp tool to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools to remove the terminals from the connectors The J-38125 does not contain wire that is suitable to high temperature exposure. Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature of the same or larger gage size as the original wire when repair damage wire. Also replace any reflective tape that you remove during the repair. HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature rating of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125 and then encapsulate the splice sleeve using the high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the order listed. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip keeping all of the wire strands intact. Page 7670 6. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by pressing on the tang. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (SENSOR) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) tool into the cavity on the lower right hand face of the connector until the terminal release tang access panel slides over. Page 4721 3. Radiator outlet hose (lower hose) to engine (3). (Shown as viewed from below.) 4. Radiator outlet hose (lower hose) to radiator (4). (Shown as viewed from below.) 5. Heater inlet hose to engine (5). Page 5059 1. Install the new muffler to the tail pipe. 2. Attach the muffler and tail pipe to the hanger insulators. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 3. Install the muffler to the catalytic converter and secure with the nuts. Tighten the nuts to 45 N.m (33 lb ft). 4. Loosely install the clamp to secure the muffler to the tail pipe. 5. Align the tail pipe in the proper position. Tighten the clamp nuts to 50 N.m (37 lb ft). 6. Inspect the exhaust system for leaks and underbody contact. 7. Install the frame brace. Refer to Frame Brace Replacement (TrailBlazer EXT, Envoy XL) Frame Brace Replacement (TrailBlazer, Envoy, Bravada). 8. Lower the vehicle. Page 8157 7. Apply pressure and gently rock the cover until one locking leg is unseated. 8. Continue to apply pressure and rock the cover until the second locking leg is unseated. Repeat procedure for the other side of the dress cover and remove the cover. 9. Use J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) to gently lift the terminal retaining tab while gently pulling the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 10. If the terminal is severely bent or damaged, it may be possible on some connectors to push the wire out of the front of the connector instead of HVAC - Manual Control Module HVAC: Diagrams HVAC - Manual HVAC Connector End Views HVAC Control Module C1 Page 1862 - Kostel - Molex - Sumitomo - Tyco/AMP - Yazaki Identifying the manufacturer of a connector is often difficult. When trying to determine the manufacturer of a connector, look for specific identifying marks that are unique to that connector supplier. Most of these identify marks are hard to find or see. Check the connector carefully and refer to the information below for pictures and descriptions of connector identification markings. - Most of AFLs connectors have EPC on their connector body. Some of the smaller connectors will not have any markings on them. - In some cases Bosch will actually be printed on the connector. If Bosch does not appear on the connector, look for the Bosch logo. The Bosch logo is a circle with a blunted arrow inside. This logo can appear anywhere on the connector and is often very small. Page 7328 vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide variety of actions, including: - Wiggling the harness - Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting - Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector - Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation - Relocating a harness or wires All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. Another option is, with the component commanded ON and OFF by the scan tool, move related connectors and wiring and observe the component operation. With the engine running, move related connectors and wiring while monitoring engine operation. If harness or connector movement affects the data displayed, component/system operation, or engine operation, inspect and repair the harness/connections as necessary. You may need to load the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these cases you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide good results as well. There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions, along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the circuit to these kinds of conditions. SALT WATER SPRAY Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture. Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5 percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously. HIGH TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070. Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault condition. The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis. This option does not allow for the same control, however. LOW TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect. If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to -18°C (0°F) from one end and +71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized cooling needs. Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or components in an effort to duplicate the concern. DUPLICATING FAILURE CONDITIONS - If none of the previous tests are successful, attempt to duplicate and/or capture the failure conditions. Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, where applicable, contains the conditions that were present when the DTC set. 1. Review and record Freeze Frame/Failure Records data. 2. Clear the DTCs using the scan tool. 3. Turn the key to OFF and wait 15 seconds. 4. Operate the vehicle under the same conditions that were noted in Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, as closely as possible. The vehicle must also be operating within the Conditions for Running the DTC. Refer to Conditions for Running the DTC in the supporting text if a DTC is being diagnosed. 5. Monitor DTC Status for the DTC being tested. The scan tool will indicate Ran, when the enabling conditions have been satisfied long enough for the DTC to run. The scan tool will also indicate whether the DTC passed or failed. - An alternate method is to drive the vehicle with the DMM connected to a suspected circuit. An abnormal reading on the DMM when the concern occurs, may help you locate the concern. Measuring Frequency Page 1201 Disclaimer Page 6901 - Yazaki has a wedge or arrow shape, similar to that shown. Delphi Connectors (Micro .64) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro 64 connectors. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. The lever lock may be located on the top or sides of the wire dress cover. Page 2587 View of the connector when released from the component. View of another type of Micro 64 connector. Page 2260 5. Once the nose piece retainers are relaxed, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should raise slightly. 6. On the opposite side of the nose piece, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should release completely. If the nose piece does not come off, repeat the procedure on the opposite side. Page 1592 View of a typical Micro 64 connector. Depress the lock and pull the lever over and past the lock. Page 1735 7. Apply pressure and gently rock the cover until one locking leg is unseated. 8. Continue to apply pressure and rock the cover until the second locking leg is unseated. Repeat procedure for the other side of the dress cover and remove the cover. 9. Use J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) to gently lift the terminal retaining tab while gently pulling the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 10. If the terminal is severely bent or damaged, it may be possible on some connectors to push the wire out of the front of the connector instead of Page 1070 Driver Door Module (DDM) Cooling System - Inspecting Radiator/Heater Hose Clamps Radiator Hose: Technical Service Bulletins Cooling System - Inspecting Radiator/Heater Hose Clamps INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 06-06-02-014B Date: June 13, 2008 Subject: Inspecting Radiator and Heater Hose Clamps and Seals for Leaks During Pre-Delivery Inspection (PDI) Models: 2007 Buick Rainier 2007-2009 Chevrolet TrailBlazer, TrailBlazer SS 2007-2009 GMC Envoy 2007-2009 Saab 9-7X Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2009 model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 06-06-02-014A (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). The purpose of this bulletin is to inform dealers of required inspection of underhood and under vehicle radiator and heater hose clamps and seals for leaks and/or seepage during pre-delivery inspection (PDI). Field feedback indicates that some customers may notice engine coolant leaks shortly after delivery, which may result in an immediate decline of customer satisfaction with their new vehicle purchase. When performing a PDI on a vehicle listed in the models affected above, pay specific attention to the effectiveness of the engine coolant hose seal locations. Reposition/reclamp or replace the clamp to effect a proper system seal prior to customer delivery. Locations to Inspect During PDI Dealership personnel should examine the following locations closely during PDI (4.2L LL8 application shown in graphics below; refer to SI for specific information on 5.3L LH6 and 6.0L LS2):L LH6 and 6.0L LS2): 1. Radiator inlet hose (upper hose) to radiator (1). 2. Radiator inlet hose (upper hose) to engine (2). Page 6548 - In some cases Delphi will actually be printed on the connector. If Delphi is not printed on the connector, look for PED. In both cases there is no specific orientation for Delphi or PED and they can appear anywhere on the connector. - FCI connectors may have the FCI logo on their connectors. The logo is the letters FCI with an "A" above it. - JAE connector have JAE in small letters on their connectors. Page 7389 3. Use a small flat-bladed tool to gently pry off the dress cover by inserting the tool under the cover opposite the harness side and prying up. 4. Remove the cover. 5. Using a small flat-bladed tool, push on the side of the nose piece retainer while pushing the nose piece forward with your thumb. This will release the terminal position assurance (TPA). 6. Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) into the corresponding terminal release cavity. The release cavities are the 2 center rows of cavities on one half of the connector. Page 2370 3. Remove the dress cover by using a flat-blade tool to release the connector locking tabs and pulling off the dress cover. 4. Relieve the tension on the nose piece retainers by inserting J-38125-12A (12094429) into the single retainer slot on the end of the nose piece and gently prying out the locking tab. Repeat the process for both of the nose piece locking tabs on the opposite side of the nose piece. Page 684 Refer to the following table as a guide in selecting the correct test adapter for front probing connectors: Backprobe IMPORTANT: Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures. - Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector. - Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large of a test probe. - After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected, test for proper terminal contact. Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the connector. Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure SCAN TOOL SNAPSHOT PROCEDURE Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used Page 2641 If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs SIR/SRS WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS, and the wiring components, such as connectors and terminals. IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system terminals. Use either an SIR/SRS pigtail or a terminated lead from the SIR Repair Kit Tray. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves, in order to repair the SIR/SRS wiring - A special crimping tool - A heat torch - An instruction manual The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides the necessary low resistance contact integrity for these sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors SIR/SRS CONNECTOR REPAIR (PLASTIC BODY AND TERMINAL METAL PIN) The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made with a special plating. This plating provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. Use the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit for repairing SIR/SRS terminals and connectors. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the repair kit. The J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit contains: Various terminated leads for sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) terminal replacement - Various connector positive assurance (CPA) locks for SIR/SRS connectors - Base of steering column pigtail connectors part number 12085514 - Yellow vinyl electrical tape Pigtail repair packs are available for SIR/SRS connectors with eight or less terminals. Only the connector body is available for connectors with more than eight terminals. The terminated leads in the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit can be used to replace damaged terminals when replacing the connector body. SIR/SRS COMPONENT WIRE PIGTAIL REPAIR IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails. A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device, not by a connector. If a wiring pigtail is damaged, you must replace the entire component, with pigtail. The inflatable restraint steering wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component. SIR/SRS WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 2327 difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Bosch Connectors (ECM) BOSCH CONNECTORS (ECM) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the assist lever on the top of the connector. Move the assist lever to the forward position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 4059 - Support the GM Oil Life System, thereby minimizing the replacement of engine oil, before its life has been depleted. - Reduce the duplication of requirements for a large number of internal GM engine oil specifications. International Lubricants Standardization and Approval Committee (ILSAC) GF-5 Standard In addition to GM dexos 1(TM), a new International Lubricants Standardization and Approval Committee (ILSAC) standard called GF-5, was introduced in October 2010. - There will be a corresponding API category, called: SN Resource Conserving. The current GF-4 standard was put in place in 2004 and will become obsolete in October 2011. Similar to dexos 1(TM), the GF-5 standard will use a new fuel economy test, Sequence VID, which demands a statistically significant increase in fuel economy versus the Sequence VIB test that was used for GF-4. - It is expected that all dexos 1(TM) approved oils will be capable of meeting the GF-5 standard. However, not all GF-5 engine oils will be capable of meeting the dexos 1(TM) specification. - Like dexos(TM), the new ILSAC GF-5 standard will call for more sophisticated additives. The API will begin licensing marketers during October 2010, to produce and distribute GF-5 certified products, which are expected to include SAE 0W-20, 0W-30, 5W-20, 5W-30 and 10W-30 oils. Corporate Average Fuel Economy (CAFE) Requirements Effect on Fuel Economy Since CAFE standards were first introduced in 1974, the fuel economy of cars has more than doubled, while the fuel economy of light trucks has increased by more than 50 percent. Proposed CAFE standards call for a continuation of increased fuel economy in new cars and trucks. To meet these future requirements, all aspects of vehicle operation are being looked at more critically than ever before. New technology being introduced in GM vehicles designed to increase vehicle efficiency and fuel economy include direct injection, cam phasing, turbocharging and active fuel management (AFM). The demands of these new technologies on engine oil also are taken into consideration when determining new oil specifications. AFM for example can help to achieve improved fuel economy. However alternately deactivating and activating the cylinders by not allowing the intake and exhaust valves to open contributes to additional stress on the engine oil. Another industry trend for meeting tough fuel economy mandates has been a shift toward lower viscosity oils. dexos 1(TM) will eventually be offered in several viscosity grades in accordance with engine needs: SAE 0W-20, 5W-20, 0W-30 and 5W-30. Using the right viscosity grade oil is critical for proper engine performance. Always refer to the Maintenance section of a vehicle Owner Manual for the proper viscosity grade for the engine being serviced. GM Oil Life System in Conjunction With dexos (TM) Supports Extended Oil Change Intervals To help conserve oil while maintaining engine protection, many GM vehicles are equipped with the GM Oil Life System. This system can provide oil change intervals that exceed the traditional 3,000 mile (4,830 km) recommendation. The dexos (TM) specification, with its requirements for improved oil robustness, compliments the GM Oil Life System by supporting extended oil change intervals over the lifetime of a vehicle. If all GM customers with GM Oil Life System equipped vehicles would use the system as intended, GM estimates that more than 100 million gallons of oil could be saved annually. GM dexos 2(TM) Information Center Website Refer to the following General Motors website for dexos 2(TM) information about the different licensed brands that are currently available: http://www.gmdexos.com GM dexos 2(TM) Engine Oil Trademark and Icons Page 6525 vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide variety of actions, including: - Wiggling the harness - Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting - Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector - Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation - Relocating a harness or wires All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. Another option is, with the component commanded ON and OFF by the scan tool, move related connectors and wiring and observe the component operation. With the engine running, move related connectors and wiring while monitoring engine operation. If harness or connector movement affects the data displayed, component/system operation, or engine operation, inspect and repair the harness/connections as necessary. You may need to load the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these cases you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide good results as well. There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions, along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the circuit to these kinds of conditions. SALT WATER SPRAY Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture. Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5 percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously. HIGH TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070. Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault condition. The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis. This option does not allow for the same control, however. LOW TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect. If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to -18°C (0°F) from one end and +71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized cooling needs. Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or components in an effort to duplicate the concern. DUPLICATING FAILURE CONDITIONS - If none of the previous tests are successful, attempt to duplicate and/or capture the failure conditions. Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, where applicable, contains the conditions that were present when the DTC set. 1. Review and record Freeze Frame/Failure Records data. 2. Clear the DTCs using the scan tool. 3. Turn the key to OFF and wait 15 seconds. 4. Operate the vehicle under the same conditions that were noted in Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, as closely as possible. The vehicle must also be operating within the Conditions for Running the DTC. Refer to Conditions for Running the DTC in the supporting text if a DTC is being diagnosed. 5. Monitor DTC Status for the DTC being tested. The scan tool will indicate Ran, when the enabling conditions have been satisfied long enough for the DTC to run. The scan tool will also indicate whether the DTC passed or failed. - An alternate method is to drive the vehicle with the DMM connected to a suspected circuit. An abnormal reading on the DMM when the concern occurs, may help you locate the concern. Measuring Frequency Page 4268 1. Install the air cleaner outlet duct. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Install the air cleaner outlet duct bolt. Tighten the bolt to 10 N.m (89 lb in). 3. Tighten the clamps at the following: * MAF/IAT sensor * Throttle body Tighten the clamps to 7 N.m (62 lb in). 4. Connect the PCV fresh air tube (2) to the air cleaner resonator outlet duct (1). Engine - Noise/Damage Oil Filter Application Importance Oil Filter: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Noise/Damage Oil Filter Application Importance INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 07-06-01-016B Date: July 27, 2009 Subject: Information on Internal Engine Noise or Damage After Oil Filter Replacement Models: 2010 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X Supercede: This bulletin is being updated to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 07-06-01-016A (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). Important Engine damage that is the result of an incorrect or improperly installed engine oil filter is not a warrantable claim. The best way to avoid oil filter quality concerns is to purchase ACDelco(R) oil filters directly from GMSPO. Oil filter misapplication may cause abnormal engine noise or internal damage. Always utilize the most recent parts information to ensure the correct part number filter is installed when replacing oil filters. Do not rely on physical dimensions alone. Counterfeit copies of name brand parts have been discovered in some aftermarket parts systems. Always ensure the parts you install are from a trusted source. Improper oil filter installation may result in catastrophic engine damage. Refer to the appropriate Service Information (SI) installation instructions when replacing any oil filter and pay particular attention to procedures for proper cartridge filter element alignment. If the diagnostics in SI (Engine Mechanical) lead to the oil filter as the cause of the internal engine noise or damage, dealers should submit a field product report. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 02-00-89-002I (Information for Dealers on How to Submit a Field Product Report). Disclaimer Page 6954 The engine harness may be repaired using the J-38125. High Temperature Wiring Repairs HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperatures, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time may use materials i.e. wires, connectors, and shielding that has a higher heat rating than typical wiring. When making a repair in a high temperature area observe the following: Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature to replace any damaged wire. - Replace any heat shielding that is removed. - Cover any DuraSeal splice sleeves with SCT1 shrink tubing (available in the J-38125 Terminal Repair kit). - After making a wiring repair, ensure that the location of the wiring is not moved closer to the heat source. IDENTIFYING HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperature, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time need special considerations when making wiring repairs. Areas that may be exposed to higher temperatures can be identified by heat resistant materials that are being used in those areas. These materials may include heat reflective tape, moon tape, and high temperature shrink tubing. Also conduit and other protective coverings may be used. Because conduit or similar coverings are used throughout the vehicle regardless of the temperature, it may be necessary for the technician to determine if an area is exposed to excessive heat before making a wiring repair. Obvious areas of consideration would be any area located near the exhaust manifolds, catalytic converter, and exhaust pipes. The J-38125 contains much of the material you will need to perform repairs on areas exposed to high heat. The kit contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves to crimp and seal connections - High temperature SCT1 shrink tubing to protect the splice sleeves - A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct crimp tool to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools to remove the terminals from the connectors The J-38125 does not contain wire that is suitable to high temperature exposure. Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature of the same or larger gage size as the original wire when repair damage wire. Also replace any reflective tape that you remove during the repair. HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature rating of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125 and then encapsulate the splice sleeve using the high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the order listed. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip keeping all of the wire strands intact. Page 1746 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. JST Connectors JST CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, remove the connector from the component. Page 5858 5. Once the nose piece retainers are relaxed, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should raise slightly. 6. On the opposite side of the nose piece, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should release completely. If the nose piece does not come off, repeat the procedure on the opposite side. Page 2486 9. The illustration shows a cutaway view of the connector to aid the technician in releasing the terminal retainer. 10. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Terminal Position Assurance Locks TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Tyco/Amp Connectors (CM 42-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (CM 42-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the connector body and pull the CPA out. The CPA is on the wire harness side of connector. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 440 If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the DuraSeal splice sleeves. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: - Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. - Do not use the crimp and DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 to crimp DuraSeal splice sleeve. In order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 2199 Page 3420 5. While pushing the terminal forward, insert the J 38125-24 in the release cavity above the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (43-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Page 3918 7. Wrap electrical tape around the connection as shown. 8. Route the engine coolant heater cord and extension cord behind the alternator and adjacent to the engine coolant crossover pipe as shown. 9. Continue to route the extension cord to the exit location desired by the customer as shown. 10. Review the routing of the coolant heater cord and extension cord to verify that it does not touch any sharp edges that could damage it. 11. Secure the engine coolant heater cord and the extension cord with tie straps as needed. 12. Resecure any of the original clips that retained the engine coolant heater cord to the vehicle that were released to provide length. Part Information The extension cord may be obtained at any of the following outlets: - Lowes* - Home Depot* - Canada: Acklands-Grainger* (www.acklandsgrainger.com), Catalogue Part Number: CWRSJTOW3C14-10 USA: Cords should bear the UL symbol. Canada: Cords should bear the ULc symbol or CSA approval. *We believe these sources and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume any responsibility for the products or material from these firms or for any such items that may be available from other sources. Page 3361 Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. For connectors with a bolt in the dress cover, turn the bolt counterclockwise to remove the connector from the component. 2. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. Page 829 Release the tabs that are holding the wiredress cover to the connector body. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the slots on both ends of the connector body. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. J 38125-216 can also be used to remove the nose piece. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by lifting the terminal retaining tabs on the inside of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 7636 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert terminal into the appropriate terminal holder until it hits bottom and stops. The correct terminal holder is determined by the wire size. Also ensure that the terminals wings are pointing towards the former on the tool and the release locator. 5. Insert the stripped cable into the terminal. Insulation should be visible on both sides of the terminal insulation wings. 6. Compress the handles until the ratchet automatically releases. 7. Place the terminal into the appropriate cavity and assemble the connector. Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO-PACK 100W) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W connectors. These connectors are very similar but use different terminals and have some minor physical differences also. Page 5770 4. Install the fuel feed (1) and EVAP (2) lines to the sender assembly. 5. Install the fuel tank. Page 6956 11. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 12. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 13. Center the high temperature SCT1 shrink tube over the DuraSeal splice sleeve. 14. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the high temperature heat shrink tubing. 15. Gradually move the heat from the center to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 16. Replace any reflective tape and clips that may have been remove during the repair. Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation REPAIRING DAMAGED WIRE INSULATION Wire Size Conversion Page 4799 Connector Anatomy Connector Repairs contains a list of all connector repairs. The connector repairs are listed by the connector manufacturer and then by connector type. If the technician cannot identify the manufacturer of the connector, refer to Identifying Connectors below. Knowing the connector manufacturer will assist in finding the correct connector repair from the following list: - Connector Position Assurance Locks - Terminal Position Assurance Locks - Bosch Connectors (0.64) Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) Bosch Connectors (BSK) Bosch Connectors (ECM) - Delphi Connectors (Micro.64) Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) Delphi Connectors (12-Way) - Tyco/AMP Connectors (CM 42-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) Tyco/AMP Connectors (025 Cap) Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) - Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) - Repairing Connector Terminals IDENTIFYING CONNECTORS Knowing the connector manufacturer is helpful when trying to locating the correct connector repair procedure. There are many different connector designs used on GM vehicles and it is sometimes difficult to identify the connector manufacturer. The information in this document should help with the identification of connector manufactures. The following connector manufacturers make most of the connectors found in GM vehicles: AFL/EPC (Alcoa Fujikura Ltd./Engineered Plastics Components) - Bosch - Delphi - FCI (Framatome Connectors International) - JAE (Japan Aviation Electronics) - JST (Japan Solderless Terminals) Page 3812 solenoids into the engine block lifter valley. The housing of the VLOM incorporates several bleeds in the oil passages to purge any air trapped in the VLOM or engine block. To control any contamination to the hydraulic circuits, a small replaceable oil screen is located in the VLOM oil inlet passage, below the oil pressure sensor. The oil pressure sensor is a 3-wire sensor which provides oil pressure information to the ECM. During service, use extreme care in keeping the VLOM assembly free of any contamination or foreign material. Engine Control Module (ECM) The engine control module (ECM) is responsible for the management and control of all engine functions. Each ECM comes equipped with a specific set of software/calibrations designed for that engine and vehicle application. The ECM will determine engine operating parameters, based upon information from a network of switches, sensors, modules and communication with other controllers located throughout vehicle. Internal to the ECM is an integrated circuit device called a low-side driver. The low-side driver is designed to operate internally, like an electronic switch. An individual low-side driver controls each valve lifter oil manifold (VLOM) solenoid. When enabling conditions for V4 mode are met, the ECM will command the low-side driver to ground each VLOM solenoid control circuit, in firing order sequence. Internal to the low-side driver is a fault detection circuit, which monitors the solenoid control circuit for an incorrect voltage level. If an incorrect voltage level, such as an open, high resistance, or short to ground, is detected, the low-side driver, along with the fault detection circuit, will communicate the condition to the central processor in the ECM. The ECM will then command a return to V8 mode, set a corresponding DTC, and illuminate the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) on the instrument panel. Cylinder Deactivation Inhibit Reasons Listed below are the powertrain conditions that will inhibit V4 mode, while operating under light load driving conditions: * Engine manifold vacuum low * Brake booster vacuum pressure low * Accelerator pedal position rate of increase too high, electronic throttle control * Accelerator pedal position too high, electronic throttle control * Ignition voltage out of range * Engine oil pressure out of range * Engine oil temperature out of range * Engine RPM out of range * Transmission gear incorrect * Transmission range incorrect * Transmission gear shift in progress * All cylinders activated via scan tool output control * Minimum time in V8 mode not met * Maximum V4 mode time exceeded * Engine oil aeration present * Decel fuel cutoff active * Fuel shut-off timer active * Minimum heater temp low, HVAC system * Reduced engine power active, electronic throttle control * Brake torque management active * Axle torque limiting active * Engine metal over temperature protection active * Catalytic converter over temperature protection active * Piston protection active, knock detected * Hot coolant mode active * Engine over speed protection active * Fault Active or Fault Pending-cylinder deactivation is disabled for the following faults: - Brake Booster Pressure Sensor - Manifold Absolute Pressure Sensor - Engine Oil Pressure Sensor - Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor - Vehicle Speed Sensor - Crankshaft Position Sensor - Engine Misfire Detected - Cylinder Deactivation Solenoid Driver Circuit The scan tool output control is used to deactivate half of the engine cylinders, V4 mode, by commanding all of the solenoids ON, or deactivate one cylinder switching to a V7 mode, by commanding ON one solenoid. Listed below are the powertrain conditions that will inhibit V4 mode, or V7 mode, with the engine running, while using the scan tool output control function: * Engine speed out of range Page 3770 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. 4. Remove the dress cover by using a flat bladed tool to release the dress cover locking tabs and lift up on the dress cover. 5. Cut the tie wrap that holds the wires to the connector body. Page 2578 11. Insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) into the 2 triangular cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 12. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE 1. Prior to installation the terminal must be aligned so the (1) coding lugs align with the (2) coding grooves on the connector. 2. Once the terminal is aligned, slide the terminal into the cavity until the retainer has engaged in the cavity of the connector. 3. Slide the TPA in the connector body and seat it using a small flat bladed tool. The TPA is seated when it is flush with the contact housing. 4. Secure the wires to the connector body using a tie wrap and replace the dress cover and grommet. Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) BOSCH CONNECTORS (2.8 JPT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Pull out the slider on the connector position assurance (CPA) until it is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 5943 to analyze the data during the time a vehicle condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a trigger point that you have determined. Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2 snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a first-in, first-out basis. If a third snapshot is taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost. Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types: Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice - Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200 frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not lost if the Scan Tool is powered down. The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis. The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected values by plotting 3 parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful, especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC. Testing for a Short to Voltage TESTING FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4. Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt, there is a short to voltage in the circuit. Testing for Continuity TESTING FOR CONTINUITY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6. Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit. 7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity. With a Test Lamp IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits. 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6. If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity. Testing for Electrical Intermittents TESTING FOR ELECTRICAL INTERMITTENTS Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment. - Testing for Short to Ground - Testing for Continuity - Testing for a Short to Voltage Page 7421 Engine Control Module: Connector Views Engine Control Module Connector End Views Engine Control Module (ECM) C1 Page 2021 8. Insert the J 38125-213 into the small terminal release hole on the nose piece and gently pull on the back of the wire. 9. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Repairing Connector Terminals REPAIRING CONNECTOR TERMINALS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following: Push to Seat terminals - Pull to Seat terminals Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your terminal repair. The J-38125 contains further information. 1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.For cable seal terminals, remove the seal. 2. Apply the correct cable seal per gage size of the wire, if used.Slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation removal. 3. Remove the insulation. 4. For sealed terminals only, align the seal with the end of the cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal.For sealed terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal. 6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.For sealed terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable. 8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals excepting Micro-Pack 100.64 size. Soldering Micro-Pack 100 World terminals may damage the terminal. Sumitomo Connectors SUMITOMO CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Engine - Low Oil Lamp ON/Oil Leaks Oil Pressure Sensor: Customer Interest Engine - Low Oil Lamp ON/Oil Leaks TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 07-06-01-004A Date: November 25, 2008 Subject: All Vortec(R) GEN IV V8 Engines - LY2 LS4 LC9 LH6 LMG LY5 LS2 L76 LY6 L92 LS7, Low Oil Level Indicator Lamp On and/or Engine Oil Leak (Reseal Oil Pressure Sensor) Models Supercede: This bulletin is being updated to include a labor operation number for CTS-V and Corvette models. Please discard Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 07-06-01-004 (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System). Condition Some customers may comment on a low oil level indicator lamp on and/or engine oil leak. Upon further investigation, the technician may find that the oil leak is at the oil pressure sensor that is threaded into the valve lifter oil manifold (VLOM) assembly and/or engine valley cover. Correction If the engine oil leak was found to be at the engine oil pressure sensor, then remove the oil pressure sensor and reseal with a pipe sealant with Teflon or equivalent, P/N 12346004 (in Canada, P/N 10953480). Refer to Engine Oil Pressure Sensor and/or Switch Replacement in SI. Parts Information Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models) Page 8057 6. Gently pry the plastic terminal retainer down and carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (16-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, pull the two connector halves apart. Page 5403 Page 1594 Depress the locks that are located on both sides of the wiredress cover and pull the lever over and past the locks. View of the connector when released from the component. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the front of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool push down on one of the locking tabs and pull the cover up until the dress cover releases. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. Page 2987 4. Install the oil pan and a new gasket. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 5. Install the oil pan bolts. Tighten the oil pan to transmission case bolts alternately and evenly to 11 N.m (97 lb in). 6. If previously removed, install the range selector cable bracket and bolts. Tighten the bolts to 25 N.m (18 lb ft). 7. Apply a small amount of sealant GM P/N 12346004 to the threads of the oil pan drain plug, if equipped. 8. Install the oil pan drain plug, if equipped. Tighten the oil pan drain plug to 18 N.m (13 lb ft). 9. Install the catalytic converter. Refer to Catalytic Converter Replacement (4.2L Engine) Catalytic Converter Replacement (5.3L and 6.0L Engines). 10. Lower the vehicle. 11. Fill the transmission to the proper level with DEXRON(R) III transmission fluid. Refer to Transmission Fluid Checking and Fluid Capacity Specifications. 12. Check the COLD fluid level reading for initial fill only. 13. Inspect the oil pan gasket for leaks. Page 7609 to analyze the data during the time a vehicle condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a trigger point that you have determined. Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2 snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a first-in, first-out basis. If a third snapshot is taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost. Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types: Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice - Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200 frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not lost if the Scan Tool is powered down. The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis. The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected values by plotting 3 parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful, especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC. Testing for a Short to Voltage TESTING FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4. Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt, there is a short to voltage in the circuit. Testing for Continuity TESTING FOR CONTINUITY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6. Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit. 7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity. With a Test Lamp IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits. 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6. If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity. Testing for Electrical Intermittents TESTING FOR ELECTRICAL INTERMITTENTS Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment. - Testing for Short to Ground - Testing for Continuity - Testing for a Short to Voltage Page 4524 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Kostal Connectors KOSTAL CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 2467 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the TPA. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the nose piece. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. Page 5801 MEASURING FREQUENCY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal. IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM to autorange to an appropriate range. 1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency measured. Measuring Voltage MEASURING VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit. 1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods: - Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. - Turn ON the engine. - Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls. - Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested. 3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The DMM displays the voltage measured at that point. Measuring Voltage Drop MEASURING VOLTAGE DROP NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points. Probing Electrical Connectors PROBING ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS Page 3403 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the rear TPA from the connector. 7. IMPORTANT: The front TPA cannot be removed from the connector. Only move it to the release point. Use a small flat-blade tool to move the front TPA to the release position. 8. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 9. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Molex Connectors Page 7493 5. Insert the J 38125-557 (GM P/N 12122378) into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 6. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Connector Position Assurance Locks CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of the connector. CPAs are used in various connectors throughout the vehicle. CPAs are also used in all SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals, of the connector. Connector Repairs CONNECTOR REPAIRS Page 6542 IMPORTANT: Ensure that the dress cover and connector body are both in the released position before reassembling. Failure to do so may cause damage to the connector and component. Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (0.64) BOSCH CONNECTORS (0.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While pressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock until the lever is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Pull the rubber boot that covers the wires back to expose the end of the connector dress cover. 4. Place the connector locking lever in the center of the connector. 5. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs that are on the wire end of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover and connector body and pry up. Page 8049 4. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the rear of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. 5. Once the locking tabs are unlocked, slide the inner connector out of the rear of the connector housing. Page 133 Method 3 The Gen 6.1 version of OnStar(R) does not require the use of the Service Programming System (SPS) to change the voice recognition system. However, there are three ways to change the language. Disclaimer Page 1540 20. Extract a portion of the ECT sensor harness wiring and connector from the protective conduit. Cut off the ECT sensor harness connector and wiring. 21. Determine a routing path for the ECT sensor jumper harness wires so that they can be secured TO or WITHIN an existing protective conduit. Note This step is to set up and verify the length of wiring that is required before cutting. 22. Route the ECT sensor jumper wires and then enclose them in their own protective conduit in order to VERIFY the length that is required. 23. Cut the ECT sensor jumper wires to the appropriate length. Note Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splice or connector. 24. Splice the ECT sensor jumper wires to the ORIGINAL ECT HARNESS LOCATION using DuraSeal weatherproof splices. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves in SI. Note Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splice or connector. 25. Splice the ECT sensor jumper wires to the ECT SENSOR HARNESS CONNECTOR using DuraSeal weatherproof splices. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves in SI. 26. Connect the ECT sensor harness connector to the ECT sensor. 27. Secure the ECT sensor jumper wires that are in their own protective conduit TO or WITHIN the existing harness conduit using tie straps. Important You MUST run the engine at the specified RPM and until it reaches normal operating temperature and then allow it to idle as indicated in SI. The engine MUST then be allowed to cool down in order to top off the coolant level as needed. 28. Fill the cooling system to the proper level. Refer to Cooling System Draining and Filling in SI. 29. Pressure test the cooling system. Refer to Cooling System Leak Testing in SI. 30. Use a scan tool to clear any DTCs. Relocating the Engine Coolant Heater Cord Important For reference, the procedure and graphics that are shown are from a Chevrolet Silverado, but are similar for the other vehicles listed above. 1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Ask the customer where they would prefer the extension cord to exit from the engine compartment in order to determine the required extension cord length. 3. Obtain an extension cord with the following features: - 120 volt - 14/3 gauge - 15A capacity - Three prong - Polarized plug and receptacle - Chemical resistant - Grounded terminals - Designed for use in a cold outdoor environment - Outer jacket resistant to deterioration from moisture, abrasion and exposure to sunlight - Maximum length of 2.5-3 m (8-10 ft) 4. Release enough of the clips that retain the engine coolant heater cord to the vehicle to provide the necessary length for repositioning. 5. Apply dielectric grease to the electrical contacts of the heater cord receptacle and the extension cord plug to prevent corrosion. Use GM P/N 12345579 (in Canada, use P/N 10953481) or an equivalent. 6. Connect the heater cord receptacle to the extension cord plug and wipe OFF any excess grease. Page 8185 7. Pressing the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool in the release cavity of the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and crimper in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (DOOR MODULE) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Side view of connector. View of top of connector. 1. Locate the assist lever and lock on the top of the connector. Page 3782 6. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by pressing on the tang. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (SENSOR) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) tool into the cavity on the lower right hand face of the connector until the terminal release tang access panel slides over. Page 5616 Page 8551 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) and slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. Page 502 pulling it through. This will prevent damage to the internal seals of the connector. Once the terminal is pushed out of the connector, cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible and pull the wire through the connector. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE The Micro-Pack 100W connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool was developed to crimp Micro-Pack 100W terminals. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 2. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert the terminal into the crimp tool until the core wings are flush with the anvil on the crimp tool. Be sure that the wings are pointed toward the crimp tool former and release the spring locator. The locator will hold the terminal in place. Inspect the alignment of the terminal wings with the crimp tool former. If the terminal wings are wider than the crimp tool former, remove the terminal and bend the terminal wings in slightly. 5. Place stripped wire into terminal. 6. Crimp the new terminal to the wire. If a jam occurs, press the emergency release to open applicator. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire perform the following procedure in order to replace Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. Page 8825 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Kostal Connectors KOSTAL CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 6386 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link). - The wire insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. 5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold them between thumb and forefinger. 7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place. - Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction. - Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip. 8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool closes.Ensure that no strands of wire are cut. 10. Crimp the splice on each end (2). Page 2663 1 - Frame - Front 2 - Electronic Frontal Sensor (EFS) - Left 3 - Electronic Frontal Sensor (EFS) Right Beneath Passenger Seat Cushion Page 7807 8. Insert the J 38125-213 into the small terminal release hole on the nose piece and gently pull on the back of the wire. 9. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Repairing Connector Terminals REPAIRING CONNECTOR TERMINALS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following: Push to Seat terminals - Pull to Seat terminals Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your terminal repair. The J-38125 contains further information. 1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.For cable seal terminals, remove the seal. 2. Apply the correct cable seal per gage size of the wire, if used.Slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation removal. 3. Remove the insulation. 4. For sealed terminals only, align the seal with the end of the cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal.For sealed terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal. 6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.For sealed terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable. 8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals excepting Micro-Pack 100.64 size. Soldering Micro-Pack 100 World terminals may damage the terminal. Sumitomo Connectors SUMITOMO CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 1434 Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested: - Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. - Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a component or to other harnesses. - If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A TEST LAMP TOOLS REQUIRED J 35616-200 Test Light - Probe Kit NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminate even though voltage is present. The J 35616-200 is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair of leads. To properly operate this tool use the following procedures. When testing for voltage: 1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested. When testing for ground: 1. Attach one lead to battery positive voltage. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where ground should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is ground at the point being tested. Using Connector Test Adapters USING CONNECTOR TEST ADAPTERS NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Using Fused Jumper Wires USING FUSED JUMPER WIRES TOOLS REQUIRED J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged. The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested. AFL/ECP Connectors AFL/EPC CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 8390 difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Bosch Connectors (ECM) BOSCH CONNECTORS (ECM) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the assist lever on the top of the connector. Move the assist lever to the forward position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 5426 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. 4. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front of the connector. Page 6900 - Most Molex connectors will have the Molex logo on the dresscover of the connector. In some cases the connectors may have MX followed by another letter. The third letter indicates where the connector was made. A connector with MXD is a Molex connector made in Detroit. Sumitomo has a unique symbol on their connector and possibly a part number. The symbol is similar to that of a diamond lying on its side, similar to that shown. The logo could appear anywhere but the most common place is at the wire side of the housing. Tyco/AMP has many different and unique connector designs. Some may or may not have identifiable marks on them. Page 1614 View of typical connector. View of connector in released position. 1. Locate the assist lever at the back of the connector. Move the assist lever to the rear position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the dress cover. Page 4759 Radiator Hose: Service and Repair Radiator Outlet Hose Replacement Radiator Outlet Hose Replacement (LH6, LS2) Tools Required J 38185 Hose Clamp Pliers Removal Procedure 1. Drain the cooling system. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System (LL8) Draining and Filling Cooling System (LH6, LS2). 2. Using J 38185 reposition the radiator outlet hose clamp (3). 3. Remove the radiator outlet hose (2) from the radiator. 4. Using J 38185 reposition the radiator outlet hose clamp. 5. Remove the radiator outlet hose from the engine (5). 6. Remove the radiator outlet hose. Installation Procedure Page 3203 2. Pressure bleed the hydraulic brake system in order to purge any air that may still be trapped in the system. 22. Turn the ignition key ON, with the engine OFF. Check to see if the brake system warning lamp remains illuminated. Important: If the brake system warning lamp remains illuminated, DO NOT allow the vehicle to be driven until it is diagnosed and repaired. 23. If the brake system warning lamp remains illuminated, refer to Symptoms - Hydraulic Brakes. Pressure Hydraulic Brake System Bleeding (Pressure) Tools Required ^ J 29532 Diaphragm Pressure Bleeder, or equivalent ^ J 35589-A Brake Pressure Bleeder Adapter Caution: Refer to Brake Fluid Irritant Caution. Notice: Refer to Brake Fluid Effects on Paint and Electrical Components Notice. Notice: When adding fluid to the brake master cylinder reservoir, use only Delco Supreme 11(R), GM P/N 12377967 (Canadian P/N 992667), or equivalent DOT-3 brake fluid from a clean, sealed brake fluid container. The use of any type of fluid other than the recommended type of brake fluid, may cause contamination which could result in damage to the internal rubber seals and/or rubber linings of hydraulic brake system components. 1. Place a clean shop cloth beneath the brake master cylinder to prevent brake fluid spills. 2. With the ignition OFF and the brakes cool, apply the brakes 3-5 times, or until the brake pedal effort increases significantly, in order to deplete the brake booster power reserve. 3. If you have performed a brake master cylinder bench bleeding on this vehicle, or if you disconnected the brake pipes from the master cylinder, you must perform the following steps: 1. Ensure that the brake master cylinder reservoir is full to the maximum-fill level. If necessary add Delco Supreme 11(R), GM P/N 12377967 (Canadian P/N 992667), or equivalent DOT-3 brake fluid from a clean, sealed brake fluid container. If removal of the reservoir cap and diaphragm is necessary, clean the outside of the reservoir on and around the cap prior to removal. 2. With the rear brake pipe installed securely to the master cylinder, loosen and separate the front brake pipe from the front port of the brake master cylinder. 3. Allow a small amount of brake fluid to gravity bleed from the open port of the master cylinder. 4. Reconnect the brake pipe to the master cylinder port and tighten securely. 5. Have an assistant slowly depress the brake pedal fully and maintain steady pressure on the pedal. 6. Loosen the same brake pipe to purge air from the open port of the master cylinder. 7. Tighten the brake pipe, then have the assistant slowly release the brake pedal. 8. Wait 15 seconds, then repeat steps 3.3-3.7 until all air is purged from the same port of the master cylinder. 9. With the front brake pipe installed securely to the master cylinder, after all air has been purged from the front port of the master cylinder, loosen and separate the rear brake pipe from the master cylinder, then repeat steps 3.3-3.8. 10. After completing the final master cylinder port bleeding procedure, ensure that both of the brake pipe-to-master cylinder fittings are properly tightened. 4. Fill the brake master cylinder reservoir to the maximum-fill level with Delco Supreme 11(R), GM P/N 12377967 (Canadian P/N 992667), or equivalent DOT-3 brake fluid from a clean, sealed brake fluid container. Clean the outside of the reservoir on and around the reservoir cap prior to removing the cap and diaphragm. 5. Install the J 35589-A to the brake master cylinder reservoir. 6. Check the brake fluid level in the J 29532, or equivalent. Add Delco Supreme 11(R), GM P/N 12377967 (Canadian P/N 992667), or equivalent DOT-3 brake fluid from a clean, sealed brake fluid container as necessary to bring the level to approximately the half-full point. 7. Connect the J 29532, or equivalent, to the J 35589-A. 8. Charge the J 29532, or equivalent, air tank to 175-205 kPa (25-30 psi). 9. Open the J 29532, or equivalent, fluid tank valve to allow pressurized brake fluid to enter the brake system. 10. Wait approximately 30 seconds, then inspect the entire hydraulic brake system in order to ensure that there are no existing external brake fluid leaks. Any brake fluid leaks identified require repair prior to completing this procedure. 11. Install a proper box-end wrench onto the RIGHT REAR wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve. 12. Install a transparent hose over the end of the bleeder valve. 13. Submerge the open end of the transparent hose into a transparent container partially filled with Delco Supreme 11(R), GM P/N 12377967 (Canadian P/N 992667), or equivalent DOT-3 brake fluid from a clean, sealed brake fluid container. 14. Loosen the bleeder valve to purge air from the wheel hydraulic circuit. Allow fluid to flow until air bubbles stop flowing from the bleeder, then tighten the bleeder valve. 15. With the right rear wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve tightened securely, after all air has been purged from the right rear hydraulic circuit, install a proper box-end wrench onto the LEFT REAR wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve. 16. Install a transparent hose over the end of the bleeder valve, then repeat steps 13-14. Page 5693 Depress the locks that are located on both sides of the wiredress cover and pull the lever over and past the locks. View of the connector when released from the component. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the front of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool push down on one of the locking tabs and pull the cover up until the dress cover releases. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. Page 8480 4. Remove the fuel sender assembly (2) and seal (3). Discard the seal. Caution: Refer to Fuel Storage Caution. 5. Clean the fuel sender sealing surfaces (4). Important: Some lock ring were manufactured with DO NOT REUSE stamped into them. These lock rings may be reused if they are not damaged or warped. Important: Inspect the lock ring for damage due to improper removal or installation procedures. If damage is found, install a NEW lock ring. Important: Check the lock ring for flatness. 6. Place the lock ring on a flat surface. Measure the clearance between to lock ring and the flat surface using a feeler gage at 7 points. 7. If the warpage is less than 0.41 mm (0.016 in), the lock ring does not require replacement. 8. If the warpage is greater than 0.41 mm (0.016 in), the lock ring must be replaced. Installation Procedure Page 717 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Ensure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the Terminal Removal Procedure. Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PULL TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL If the terminal is visibly damaged or is suspected of having a faulty connection, the terminal should be replaced. Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors: 1. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) device and/or the secondary lock. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component or separate the connectors for in-line connectors. 3. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device. 4. Insert the proper pick or removal tool into the front of the connector body. 5. IMPORTANT: On connectors with more than one terminal the service loop may not be large enough to remove the terminal and crimp on a new one. If the terminal wire does not have a large enough service loop for removal, cut the wire 5 cm (2 in) behind the connector before removal. Grasp the wire at the back of the connector body and gently push the terminal out the front of the connector body. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. If the wire needed to be cut in order to remove the terminal, gently push a small length of the same size wire through the back of the connector cavity until there is enough wire exposed in order to crimp on a new terminal. If the wire was not cut, cut the existing wire as close to the old terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 4. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. TERMINAL INSTALLATION 1. Align the terminal and pull the wire from the back of the connector in order to seat the terminal. 2. If necessary, cut the new wire to proper length and splice with existing circuit. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. 3. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply dielectric grease to the connector. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PUSH TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 6582 3. Remove the dress cover by using a flat-blade tool to release the connector locking tabs and pulling off the dress cover. 4. Relieve the tension on the nose piece retainers by inserting J-38125-12A (12094429) into the single retainer slot on the end of the nose piece and gently prying out the locking tab. Repeat the process for both of the nose piece locking tabs on the opposite side of the nose piece. Page 6298 Page 721 Release the lower wiredress cover locking tab. Release the upper wiredress cover locking tab. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. Page 5141 Page 6561 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Ensure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the Terminal Removal Procedure. Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PULL TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL If the terminal is visibly damaged or is suspected of having a faulty connection, the terminal should be replaced. Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors: 1. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) device and/or the secondary lock. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component or separate the connectors for in-line connectors. 3. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device. 4. Insert the proper pick or removal tool into the front of the connector body. 5. IMPORTANT: On connectors with more than one terminal the service loop may not be large enough to remove the terminal and crimp on a new one. If the terminal wire does not have a large enough service loop for removal, cut the wire 5 cm (2 in) behind the connector before removal. Grasp the wire at the back of the connector body and gently push the terminal out the front of the connector body. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. If the wire needed to be cut in order to remove the terminal, gently push a small length of the same size wire through the back of the connector cavity until there is enough wire exposed in order to crimp on a new terminal. If the wire was not cut, cut the existing wire as close to the old terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 4. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. TERMINAL INSTALLATION 1. Align the terminal and pull the wire from the back of the connector in order to seat the terminal. 2. If necessary, cut the new wire to proper length and splice with existing circuit. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. 3. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply dielectric grease to the connector. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PUSH TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 901 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the DuraSeal splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of a connector. CPAs are used in all SIR System connectors and also in some connectors of other systems. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals of a connection. TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE CLIPS IMPORTANT: When making a splice in an area that may be exposed to moisture use a crimp and seal splice sleeve instead of a Splice Clip. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. Page 4011 Drive Belt Tensioner: Service and Repair Drive Belt Tensioner Replacement - Air Conditioning Drive Belt Tensioner Replacement - Air Conditioning Removal Procedure 1. Remove the air conditioning (A/C) drive belt. Refer to Drive Belt Replacement - Air Conditioning. 2. Raise and suitably support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 3. Remove the A/C belt tensioner bolts. 4. Remove the A/C belt tensioner. Installation Procedure 1. Install the A/C belt tensioner. Page 6079 difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Bosch Connectors (ECM) BOSCH CONNECTORS (ECM) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the assist lever on the top of the connector. Move the assist lever to the forward position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 1860 5. Insert the J 38125-557 (GM P/N 12122378) into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 6. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Connector Position Assurance Locks CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of the connector. CPAs are used in various connectors throughout the vehicle. CPAs are also used in all SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals, of the connector. Connector Repairs CONNECTOR REPAIRS Page 8444 5. While pushing the terminal forward, insert the J 38125-24 in the release cavity above the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (43-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Page 5369 11. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 12. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 13. Center the high temperature SCT1 shrink tube over the DuraSeal splice sleeve. 14. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the high temperature heat shrink tubing. 15. Gradually move the heat from the center to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 16. Replace any reflective tape and clips that may have been remove during the repair. Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation REPAIRING DAMAGED WIRE INSULATION Wire Size Conversion Locations Suspension Mode Switch: Locations Air Suspension Component Views Rear Frame and Underbody Rear Frame and Underbody - Short Wheelbase (SWB) 1 - Air Suspension Sensor - LR 2 - Air Suspension Sensor - RR 3 - Air Suspension Compressor Assembly 4 - Air Suspension Inflator Switch 5 - Frame Page 675 Utility/Van Zoning UTILITY/VAN ZONING Page 1511 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link). - The wire insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. 5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold them between thumb and forefinger. 7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place. - Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction. - Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip. 8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool closes.Ensure that no strands of wire are cut. 10. Crimp the splice on each end (2). Page 8943 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the rear TPA from the connector. 7. IMPORTANT: The front TPA cannot be removed from the connector. Only move it to the release point. Use a small flat-blade tool to move the front TPA to the release position. 8. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 9. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Molex Connectors Page 8751 Oxygen Sensor: Service Precautions Heated Oxygen Sensor Resistance Learn Reset Notice Heated Oxygen Sensor Resistance Learn Reset Notice Notice: When replacing the HO2S perform the following: * A code clear with a scan tool, regardless of whether or not a DTC is set * HO2S heater resistance learn reset with a scan tool, where available Perform the above in order to reset the HO2S resistance learned value and avoid possible HO2S failure. Page 8142 11. Insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) into the 2 triangular cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 12. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE 1. Prior to installation the terminal must be aligned so the (1) coding lugs align with the (2) coding grooves on the connector. 2. Once the terminal is aligned, slide the terminal into the cavity until the retainer has engaged in the cavity of the connector. 3. Slide the TPA in the connector body and seat it using a small flat bladed tool. The TPA is seated when it is flush with the contact housing. 4. Secure the wires to the connector body using a tie wrap and replace the dress cover and grommet. Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) BOSCH CONNECTORS (2.8 JPT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Pull out the slider on the connector position assurance (CPA) until it is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 4409 Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. FCI Connectors FCI CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 6654 Knock Sensor: Diagnostic Aids Arrows and Symbols Arrows and Symbols This Service Data uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations. Arrows and Symbols 1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow Basic Knowledge Required GENERAL ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures contained in the service manual. You should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current (amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram, as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. Decimal and Metric Equivalents Decimal and Metric Equivalents Page 2688 Seat Position Sensor: Diagrams SIR Connector End Views Inflatable Restraint Seat Position Sensor (SPS) - Left A/T Shift Lock Control Solenoid Inflatable Restraint Seat Position Sensor (SPS) - Right A/T Shift Lock Control Solenoid Page 6195 - A control module from another vehicle is installed. - Revised software/calibration files have been released for this vehicle. - IMPORTANT: DO NOT re-program the control module with the SAME software/calibration files that are already present in the control module. This is not an effective repair for any type of concern. Verify that the control module contains the correct software/calibration. If incorrect programming is found, reprogram the control module with the most current software/calibration. Refer to Control Module References for replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Testing for Short to Ground TESTING FOR SHORT TO GROUND NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 4. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit. With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is a short to ground in the circuit. Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2. Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). - When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. - If the DMM does not display voltage 4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is shorted. Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A DIGITAL MULTIMETER NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the powertrain control module (PCM), should only be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200 Digital Multimeter (DMM). The J 39200 instruction manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminage even though voltage is present. The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity. IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading. Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the measurement. Page 4592 It is very important to use the correct test adapter when testing for proper terminal contact of fuses and relays in a bussed electrical center (BEC). Use J-35616-35 to test for proper terminal contact. Failure to use J-35616-35 can result in improper diagnosis of the BEC. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Separate the connector halves. 2. Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body. 3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J-38125 , test that the retention force is significantly different between a good terminal and a suspect terminal. Replace the female terminal in question. FLAT WIRE (DOCK AND LOCK) CONNECTORS There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock) connectors on the harness side or the component side. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Remove the component in question. 2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side of the connector as oil from your skin may be a source of contamination as well. 3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other imperfections that could cause poor terminal contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are uniform and free of damage or deformation. 4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the on the flat wire harness connector in order to test the circuit in question. CONTROL MODULE/COMPONENT VOLTAGE AND GROUNDS Poor voltage or ground connections can cause widely varying symptoms. Test all control module voltage supply circuits. Many vehicles have multiple circuits supplying voltage to a control module. Other components in the system may have separate voltage supply circuits that may also need to be tested. Inspect connections at the module/component connectors, fuses, and any intermediate connections between the voltage source and the module/component. A test lamp or a DMM may indicate that voltage is present, but neither tests the ability of the circuit to carry sufficient current. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Power Distribution Schematics. - Test all control module ground and system ground circuits. The control module may have multiple ground circuits. Other components in the system may have separate grounds that may also need to be tested. Inspect grounds for clean and tight connections at the grounding point. Inspect the connections at the component and in splice packs, where applicable. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Ground Distribution Schematics. TEMPERATURE SENSITIVITY - An intermittent condition may occur when a component/connection reaches normal operating temperature. The condition may occur only when the component/connection is cold, or only when the component/connection is hot. - Freeze Frame, Failure Records, Snapshot, or Vehicle Data Recorder data may help with this type of intermittent condition, where applicable. - If the intermittent is related to heat, review the data for a relationship with the following: High ambient temperatures - Underhood/engine generated heat - Circuit generated heat due to a poor connection, or high electrical load - Higher than normal load conditions, towing, etc. - If the intermittent is related to cold, review the data for the following: Low ambient temperatures-In extremely low temperatures, ice may form in a connection or component. Inspect for water intrusion. - The condition only occurs on a cold start. - The condition goes away when the vehicle warms up. - Information from the customer may help to determine if the trouble follows a pattern that is temperature related. - If temperature is suspected of causing an intermittent fault condition, attempt to duplicate the condition. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required. ELECTROMAGNETIC INTERFERENCE (EMI) AND ELECTRICAL NOISE Some electrical components/circuits are sensitive to electromagnetic interference (EMI) or other types of electrical noise. Inspect for the following conditions: A misrouted harness that is too close to high voltage/high current devices such as secondary ignition components, motors, generator etc-These components may induce electrical noise on a circuit that could interfere with normal circuit operation. - Electrical system interference caused by a malfunctioning relay, or a control module driven solenoid or switch-These conditions can cause a sharp electrical surge. Normally, the condition will occur when the malfunctioning component is operating. - Improper installation of non-factory or aftermarket add on accessories such as lights, 2-way radios, amplifiers, electric motors, remote starters, alarm systems, cell phones, etc-These accessories may lead to interference while in use, but do not fail when the accessories are not in use. - Test for an open diode across the A/C compressor clutch and for other open diodes. Some relays may contain a clamping diode. - The generator may be allowing AC noise into the electrical system. INCORRECT CONTROL MODULE - There are only a few situations where reprogramming a control module is appropriate: A new service control module is installed. Page 6204 5. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove TPA from the connector. 6. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Page 8866 5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape. Seat Belt Schematic Icons Seat Belt Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons Page 6744 11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the solder equipment. 12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. 13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to cover the first piece of tape. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE SLEEVES TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit IMPORTANT: Use only dura seal splice sleeves. Other splice sleeves may not protect the splice from moisture or provide a good electrical connection. Use duraseal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. Use duraseal splice sleeves where there is special requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire using duraseal splice sleeves. Page 378 Connector Anatomy Connector Repairs contains a list of all connector repairs. The connector repairs are listed by the connector manufacturer and then by connector type. If the technician cannot identify the manufacturer of the connector, refer to Identifying Connectors below. Knowing the connector manufacturer will assist in finding the correct connector repair from the following list: - Connector Position Assurance Locks - Terminal Position Assurance Locks - Bosch Connectors (0.64) Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) Bosch Connectors (BSK) Bosch Connectors (ECM) - Delphi Connectors (Micro.64) Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) Delphi Connectors (12-Way) - Tyco/AMP Connectors (CM 42-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) Tyco/AMP Connectors (025 Cap) Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) - Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) - Repairing Connector Terminals IDENTIFYING CONNECTORS Knowing the connector manufacturer is helpful when trying to locating the correct connector repair procedure. There are many different connector designs used on GM vehicles and it is sometimes difficult to identify the connector manufacturer. The information in this document should help with the identification of connector manufactures. The following connector manufacturers make most of the connectors found in GM vehicles: AFL/EPC (Alcoa Fujikura Ltd./Engineered Plastics Components) - Bosch - Delphi - FCI (Framatome Connectors International) - JAE (Japan Aviation Electronics) - JST (Japan Solderless Terminals) Page 6736 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Start in the middle and gradually move the heat barrel to the open ends of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Heated Oxygen Sensor Wiring Repairs HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being obstructed. If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. - Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks, etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire. - Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance. - To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector. Page 1344 The first connector design of the Micro-Pack 100W (1) has a white connector interface that holds the terminals. The second design of the Micro-Pack 100W (2) has a gray interface to hold the terminals. Also, the first design has terminal cavities that are further apart (3 mm centerline) and offset from the other row of terminal cavities in the connector. The second design has terminals cavities that are closer together (2.54 mm centerline) and aligned vertically. One other way to identify the second design is the thin strip of material that runs along the outside of the cavities. IMPORTANT: There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W terminals which are very similar. Ensure that you have the correct terminal before crimping the new terminal to the wire. The first design connector uses the longer terminal (1) that has a raised area in front of the recess in the terminal. The second design connector uses the shorter terminal without the raised area. Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro-Pack 100W connectors. Some Micro-Pack 100W connector disassembly procedures will vary. Use this procedure as a guide. 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 1749 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Kostal Connectors KOSTAL CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 6074 Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. For connectors with a bolt in the dress cover, turn the bolt counterclockwise to remove the connector from the component. 2. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. Page 4818 Release the lower wiredress cover locking tab. Release the upper wiredress cover locking tab. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. Page 820 Refer to the following table as a guide in selecting the correct test adapter for front probing connectors: Backprobe IMPORTANT: Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures. - Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector. - Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large of a test probe. - After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected, test for proper terminal contact. Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the connector. Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure SCAN TOOL SNAPSHOT PROCEDURE Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used Page 7991 It is very important to use the correct test adapter when testing for proper terminal contact of fuses and relays in a bussed electrical center (BEC). Use J-35616-35 to test for proper terminal contact. Failure to use J-35616-35 can result in improper diagnosis of the BEC. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Separate the connector halves. 2. Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body. 3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J-38125 , test that the retention force is significantly different between a good terminal and a suspect terminal. Replace the female terminal in question. FLAT WIRE (DOCK AND LOCK) CONNECTORS There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock) connectors on the harness side or the component side. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Remove the component in question. 2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side of the connector as oil from your skin may be a source of contamination as well. 3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other imperfections that could cause poor terminal contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are uniform and free of damage or deformation. 4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the on the flat wire harness connector in order to test the circuit in question. CONTROL MODULE/COMPONENT VOLTAGE AND GROUNDS Poor voltage or ground connections can cause widely varying symptoms. Test all control module voltage supply circuits. Many vehicles have multiple circuits supplying voltage to a control module. Other components in the system may have separate voltage supply circuits that may also need to be tested. Inspect connections at the module/component connectors, fuses, and any intermediate connections between the voltage source and the module/component. A test lamp or a DMM may indicate that voltage is present, but neither tests the ability of the circuit to carry sufficient current. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Power Distribution Schematics. - Test all control module ground and system ground circuits. The control module may have multiple ground circuits. Other components in the system may have separate grounds that may also need to be tested. Inspect grounds for clean and tight connections at the grounding point. Inspect the connections at the component and in splice packs, where applicable. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Ground Distribution Schematics. TEMPERATURE SENSITIVITY - An intermittent condition may occur when a component/connection reaches normal operating temperature. The condition may occur only when the component/connection is cold, or only when the component/connection is hot. - Freeze Frame, Failure Records, Snapshot, or Vehicle Data Recorder data may help with this type of intermittent condition, where applicable. - If the intermittent is related to heat, review the data for a relationship with the following: High ambient temperatures - Underhood/engine generated heat - Circuit generated heat due to a poor connection, or high electrical load - Higher than normal load conditions, towing, etc. - If the intermittent is related to cold, review the data for the following: Low ambient temperatures-In extremely low temperatures, ice may form in a connection or component. Inspect for water intrusion. - The condition only occurs on a cold start. - The condition goes away when the vehicle warms up. - Information from the customer may help to determine if the trouble follows a pattern that is temperature related. - If temperature is suspected of causing an intermittent fault condition, attempt to duplicate the condition. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required. ELECTROMAGNETIC INTERFERENCE (EMI) AND ELECTRICAL NOISE Some electrical components/circuits are sensitive to electromagnetic interference (EMI) or other types of electrical noise. Inspect for the following conditions: A misrouted harness that is too close to high voltage/high current devices such as secondary ignition components, motors, generator etc-These components may induce electrical noise on a circuit that could interfere with normal circuit operation. - Electrical system interference caused by a malfunctioning relay, or a control module driven solenoid or switch-These conditions can cause a sharp electrical surge. Normally, the condition will occur when the malfunctioning component is operating. - Improper installation of non-factory or aftermarket add on accessories such as lights, 2-way radios, amplifiers, electric motors, remote starters, alarm systems, cell phones, etc-These accessories may lead to interference while in use, but do not fail when the accessories are not in use. - Test for an open diode across the A/C compressor clutch and for other open diodes. Some relays may contain a clamping diode. - The generator may be allowing AC noise into the electrical system. INCORRECT CONTROL MODULE - There are only a few situations where reprogramming a control module is appropriate: A new service control module is installed. Page 3322 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches, and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original. - The wires insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the possibility of fuel contact. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1). 5. Select the proper duraseal splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool. Refer to the Crimp and Seal Splice Table. 6. Place the duraseal splice sleeve in the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115) crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 7. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to hold the duraseal splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 8. Insert the wires into the duraseal splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel in order to prevent the wire from passing through the splice (3). 9. Close the handles of the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115), until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is applied to the splice sleeve. 10. Shrink the insulation around the splice. - Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. - Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Splicing Inline Harness Diodes SPLICING INLINE HARNESS DIODES Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure. 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode. 2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool. 5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode. Page 4293 1. Relieve the fuel system pressure, if required. Perform the following steps: Caution: Wrap a shop towel around the fuel pressure connection in order to reduce the risk of fire and personal injury. The towel will absorb any fuel leakage that occurs during the connection of the fuel pressure gage. Place the towel in an approved container when the connection of the fuel pressure gage is complete. 1. Wrap a shop towel around the fuel rail service port. 2. Place the hose on the CH-48027-2 (2) into an approved gasoline container. 3. Open the valve on the CH-48027-2 (2) in order to bleed any fuel from the fuel rail. 4. Close the valve on the CH-48027-2 (2). 5. Remove the hose on the CH-48027-2 (2) from the approved gasoline container. 6. Remove the shop towel from around the fuel rail service port, and place in an approved gasoline container. Notice: Clean all of the following areas before performing any disconnections in order to avoid possible contamination in the system: * The fuel pipe connections * The hose connections * The areas surrounding the connections Disconnect the CH-48027-1 (1) from the CH-48027-2 (2). 2. Disconnect the CH-48027-2 (2) from the CH-48027-3 (4). 3. Disconnect the CH-48027-3 (4) from the fuel rail service port. 4. Install the fuel rail service port cap. 5. Tighten the fuel fill cap. Page 3247 Release the tabs that are holding the wiredress cover to the connector body. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the slots on both ends of the connector body. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. J 38125-216 can also be used to remove the nose piece. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by lifting the terminal retaining tabs on the inside of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 6415 Refer to the following table as a guide in selecting the correct test adapter for front probing connectors: Backprobe IMPORTANT: Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures. - Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector. - Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large of a test probe. - After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected, test for proper terminal contact. Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the connector. Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure SCAN TOOL SNAPSHOT PROCEDURE Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used Page 5804 to analyze the data during the time a vehicle condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a trigger point that you have determined. Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2 snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a first-in, first-out basis. If a third snapshot is taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost. Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types: Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice - Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200 frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not lost if the Scan Tool is powered down. The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis. The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected values by plotting 3 parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful, especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC. Testing for a Short to Voltage TESTING FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4. Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt, there is a short to voltage in the circuit. Testing for Continuity TESTING FOR CONTINUITY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6. Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit. 7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity. With a Test Lamp IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits. 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6. If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity. Testing for Electrical Intermittents TESTING FOR ELECTRICAL INTERMITTENTS Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment. - Testing for Short to Ground - Testing for Continuity - Testing for a Short to Voltage Engine - Low Oil Lamp ON/Oil Leaks Oil Pressure Sensor: Customer Interest Engine - Low Oil Lamp ON/Oil Leaks TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 07-06-01-004A Date: November 25, 2008 Subject: All Vortec(R) GEN IV V8 Engines - LY2 LS4 LC9 LH6 LMG LY5 LS2 L76 LY6 L92 LS7, Low Oil Level Indicator Lamp On and/or Engine Oil Leak (Reseal Oil Pressure Sensor) Models Supercede: This bulletin is being updated to include a labor operation number for CTS-V and Corvette models. Please discard Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 07-06-01-004 (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System). Condition Some customers may comment on a low oil level indicator lamp on and/or engine oil leak. Upon further investigation, the technician may find that the oil leak is at the oil pressure sensor that is threaded into the valve lifter oil manifold (VLOM) assembly and/or engine valley cover. Correction If the engine oil leak was found to be at the engine oil pressure sensor, then remove the oil pressure sensor and reseal with a pipe sealant with Teflon or equivalent, P/N 12346004 (in Canada, P/N 10953480). Refer to Engine Oil Pressure Sensor and/or Switch Replacement in SI. Parts Information Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models) Page 6122 3. Remove the dress cover by using a flat-blade tool to release the connector locking tabs and pulling off the dress cover. 4. Relieve the tension on the nose piece retainers by inserting J-38125-12A (12094429) into the single retainer slot on the end of the nose piece and gently prying out the locking tab. Repeat the process for both of the nose piece locking tabs on the opposite side of the nose piece. Page 4789 View of connector in released position. 4. Disconnect the connector from the component. 5. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Release the rear lower half of the wiredress cover. Page 8232 All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system. Page 6271 If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the DuraSeal splice sleeves. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: - Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. - Do not use the crimp and DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 to crimp DuraSeal splice sleeve. In order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 3321 11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the solder equipment. 12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. 13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to cover the first piece of tape. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE SLEEVES TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit IMPORTANT: Use only dura seal splice sleeves. Other splice sleeves may not protect the splice from moisture or provide a good electrical connection. Use duraseal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. Use duraseal splice sleeves where there is special requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire using duraseal splice sleeves. Page 5536 View of connector in released position. 4. Disconnect the connector from the component. 5. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Release the rear lower half of the wiredress cover. Diagram Information and Instructions Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions Electrical Symbols Page 4707 Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagrams Engine Controls Connector End Views Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor Page 5227 breakers are used. CIRCUIT BREAKER This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high current is removed. POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) CIRCUIT BREAKER This type greatly increases its resistance when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker will re-close within a second or 2. Circuit Protection - Fuses CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSES The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and examine the element in the fuse for an open (2). If not broken (1), also check for continuity using a DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one of equal current rating. Circuit Protection - Fusible Links CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSIBLE LINKS Page 7763 View of connector in released position. 4. Disconnect the connector from the component. 5. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Release the rear lower half of the wiredress cover. Page 6193 If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200 DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J 39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected. IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J 39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and maximum (MAX) values measured. 1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of a suspected circuit to the other. 2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J 39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep). IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value in order to record the full change. 5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling the connections or the wiring, test driving, or performing other operations. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions. 6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9. Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist. Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections TESTING FOR INTERMITTENT CONDITIONS AND POOR CONNECTIONS TOOLS REQUIRED - J 35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit - J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit When the condition is not currently present, but is indicated in DTC history, the cause may be intermittent. An intermittent may also be the cause when there is a customer complaint, but the symptom cannot be duplicated. Refer to the Symptom Table of the system that is suspect of causing the condition before trying to locate an intermittent condition. Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the following items: Wiring broken inside the insulation - Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector - Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself, and corrosion in the wire to terminal contact area, etc. - Pierced or damaged insulation can allow moisture to enter the wiring causing corrosion. The conductor can corrode inside the insulation, with little visible evidence. Look for swollen and stiff sections of wire in the suspect circuits. - Wiring which has been pinched, cut, or its insulation rubbed through may cause an intermittent open or short as the bare area touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle. - Wiring that comes in contact with hot or exhaust components - Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required, in order to verify the customer concern. - Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. - Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis and Vehicle Data Recorder operation. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any inline connectors before replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation. Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination, usually in the underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit. Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper adapter. Always use the J 35616 when probing connectors. Other causes of terminal deformation are improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT IN BUSSED ELECTRICAL CENTERS (BEC) Page 3368 5. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove TPA from the connector. 6. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Page 2325 Release the tabs that are holding the wiredress cover to the connector body. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the slots on both ends of the connector body. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. J 38125-216 can also be used to remove the nose piece. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by lifting the terminal retaining tabs on the inside of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Testing and Inspection Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Testing and Inspection Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) Diagnosis Diagnostic Fault Information Perform the Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle prior to using this diagnostic procedure. Circuit/System Description Ignition voltage is supplied to the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL). The engine control module (ECM) turns the MIL ON by grounding the MIL control circuit. Circuit/System Verification Ignition ON, the MIL should turn ON and OFF when commanded with a scan tool. Circuit/System Testing 1. Ignition OFF, disconnect the harness connector at the instrument panel cluster (IPC). 2. Ignition ON, verify that a test lamp illuminates between the ignition circuit and ground. ‹› If the test lamp does not illuminate, test the ignition circuit for a short to ground or an open/high resistance. If the circuit tests normal and the ignition circuit fuse is open, replace the IPC. 3. Connect a test lamp between the control circuit and the ignition circuit. 4. Command the MIL ON and OFF with a scan tool. The test lamp should turn ON and OFF when changing between the commanded states. ‹› If the test lamp is always ON, test the control circuit for a short to ground. If the circuit tests normal, replace the ECM. ‹› If the test lamp is always OFF, test the control circuit for a short to voltage or an open/high resistance. If the circuit tests normal, replace the ECM. 5. If all circuits test normal, replace the IPC. Repair Instructions Perform the Diagnostic Repair Verification after completing the diagnostic procedure. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests and Procedures * Control Module References See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning * Instrument Cluster Replacement Page 5135 3. Connect the MDI to a PC or laptop that has been downloaded with the GDS application from TIS2WEB. Note At least one Diagnostic Package must be installed on the PC to perform diagnostics. If GDS was just installed, select: Add New Diagnostic Package and then select: a Diagnostic Package to download. 4. Click: On the GDS icon on the PC. 5. The Login Page will appear. 6. Select: A User. 7. The ID Screen will appear. 8. Select: The serial number of the MDI being used. 9. Select: Connect. 10. Verify that the system status is ready by observing for a flashing PC light icon on the MDI. 11. Select: Make, Model and Model Year, in order to build the vehicle. 12. Click: Upload VIN, to allow the VIN to be reported to the PC. 13. At: The Verification step, turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. 14. Select: Next Action. 15. The Home Page will appear. 16. Select: Next. 17. The Diagnostic Screen will appear. Note Due to vehicle build, software and RPO variations, GDS may ask for additional information in Step 18. 18. Select: Engine ID, if prompted. 19. Select: Module Diagnostics. 20. Select: ECM. 21. Select: ID Information. 22. The Diagnostics page will appear. Typical View of GDS Calibration History Screen Note GDS is capable of displaying up to 10 Calibration History events. 23. Select: Calibration History from the drop down menu in order to display the following items on the screen: - Calibration History Buffer - Number of Calibration History Events Stored - Calibration Part Number History - Calibration Verification Number History 24. Select: Screenshot. 25. Name and save the file in an appropriate folder. 26. Select : Print, and retain a copy of the screenshot with the repair order. 27. E-mail a copy of the screenshot to [email protected]. In the subject line of the e-mail include the phrase "V8 Cal" as well as the complete VIN and Dealer BAC. In the body of the e-mail, include the VIN, mileage, R.O. number and BAC. Include a brief description of the customer concern and cause of the concern. Page 2647 6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias. Reference the appropriate service manual wiring schematic to obtain the correct diode installation position. 7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for the soldering equipment. 8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed. 9. IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode attachment points with tape. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape. Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable SPLICING TWISTED OR SHIELDED CABLE Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable. 1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splice is made. 3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire. Staggering the splices by 65 mm (2.5 in) is recommended. 4. IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical contact with the drain wire. Re-assemble the cable. Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape. - Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1). - Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire. - Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape. Page 836 11. Insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) into the 2 triangular cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 12. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE 1. Prior to installation the terminal must be aligned so the (1) coding lugs align with the (2) coding grooves on the connector. 2. Once the terminal is aligned, slide the terminal into the cavity until the retainer has engaged in the cavity of the connector. 3. Slide the TPA in the connector body and seat it using a small flat bladed tool. The TPA is seated when it is flush with the contact housing. 4. Secure the wires to the connector body using a tie wrap and replace the dress cover and grommet. Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) BOSCH CONNECTORS (2.8 JPT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Pull out the slider on the connector position assurance (CPA) until it is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 5741 If a wire is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm, etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except coaxial. - Do not use the DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent American wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 1957 Page 7485 Release the tabs that are holding the wiredress cover to the connector body. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the slots on both ends of the connector body. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. J 38125-216 can also be used to remove the nose piece. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by lifting the terminal retaining tabs on the inside of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 8087 Engine Control Module: Service Precautions Powertrain Control Module and Electrostatic Discharge Notice Notice: Do not touch the connector pins or soldered components on the circuit board in order to prevent possible electrostatic discharge (ESD) damage to the PCM. Page 1184 Low Pressure Sensor / Switch: Diagrams HVAC - Manual HVAC Connector End Views A/C Low Pressure Switch Reverse Lockout Solenoid Page 535 5. While pushing the terminal forward, insert the J 38125-24 in the release cavity above the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (43-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Page 835 6. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs located on the opposite side of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover at the connector end and pry up. 7. Remove the dress cover. 8. Cut the tie wrap on the wire bundle. 9. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting a small flat-bladed tool into the small slot in the end of the slider and pushing on the TPA until it comes out of the connector. When the TPA exits the opposite side of the connector, gasp the TPA and pull it completely out of the connector. 10. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 3387 pulling it through. This will prevent damage to the internal seals of the connector. Once the terminal is pushed out of the connector, cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible and pull the wire through the connector. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE The Micro-Pack 100W connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool was developed to crimp Micro-Pack 100W terminals. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 2. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert the terminal into the crimp tool until the core wings are flush with the anvil on the crimp tool. Be sure that the wings are pointed toward the crimp tool former and release the spring locator. The locator will hold the terminal in place. Inspect the alignment of the terminal wings with the crimp tool former. If the terminal wings are wider than the crimp tool former, remove the terminal and bend the terminal wings in slightly. 5. Place stripped wire into terminal. 6. Crimp the new terminal to the wire. If a jam occurs, press the emergency release to open applicator. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire perform the following procedure in order to replace Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. Page 6722 4. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the rear of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. 5. Once the locking tabs are unlocked, slide the inner connector out of the rear of the connector housing. Page 6506 Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Camshaft Position Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Remove the generator bracket assembly. 2. Remove the camshaft position sensor mounting bolts (1). 3. Remove the camshaft position sensor assembly (4, 5, 6) from the front cover (7). 4. Disconnect the camshaft position sensor jumper harness (2) and the engine harness (3) electrical connectors. 5. Remove the camshaft sensor assembly (4, 5, 6). 6. Disconnect camshaft position sensor (5) from the jumper harness (4). Installation Procedure 1. Reconnect the camshaft sensor (5) and the jumper harness (4). 2. Install the O-ring (6) on the camshaft sensor assembly (4, 5). 3. Reconnect the camshaft position sensor assembly (4, 5, 6) and the engine harness connector (3). Page 397 Release the lower wiredress cover locking tab. Release the upper wiredress cover locking tab. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. Page 5860 9. The illustration shows a cutaway view of the connector to aid the technician in releasing the terminal retainer. 10. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Terminal Position Assurance Locks TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Tyco/Amp Connectors (CM 42-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (CM 42-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the connector body and pull the CPA out. The CPA is on the wire harness side of connector. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 5158 It is very important to use the correct test adapter when testing for proper terminal contact of fuses and relays in a bussed electrical center (BEC). Use J-35616-35 to test for proper terminal contact. Failure to use J-35616-35 can result in improper diagnosis of the BEC. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Separate the connector halves. 2. Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body. 3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J-38125 , test that the retention force is significantly different between a good terminal and a suspect terminal. Replace the female terminal in question. FLAT WIRE (DOCK AND LOCK) CONNECTORS There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock) connectors on the harness side or the component side. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Remove the component in question. 2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side of the connector as oil from your skin may be a source of contamination as well. 3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other imperfections that could cause poor terminal contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are uniform and free of damage or deformation. 4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the on the flat wire harness connector in order to test the circuit in question. CONTROL MODULE/COMPONENT VOLTAGE AND GROUNDS Poor voltage or ground connections can cause widely varying symptoms. Test all control module voltage supply circuits. Many vehicles have multiple circuits supplying voltage to a control module. Other components in the system may have separate voltage supply circuits that may also need to be tested. Inspect connections at the module/component connectors, fuses, and any intermediate connections between the voltage source and the module/component. A test lamp or a DMM may indicate that voltage is present, but neither tests the ability of the circuit to carry sufficient current. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Power Distribution Schematics. - Test all control module ground and system ground circuits. The control module may have multiple ground circuits. Other components in the system may have separate grounds that may also need to be tested. Inspect grounds for clean and tight connections at the grounding point. Inspect the connections at the component and in splice packs, where applicable. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Ground Distribution Schematics. TEMPERATURE SENSITIVITY - An intermittent condition may occur when a component/connection reaches normal operating temperature. The condition may occur only when the component/connection is cold, or only when the component/connection is hot. - Freeze Frame, Failure Records, Snapshot, or Vehicle Data Recorder data may help with this type of intermittent condition, where applicable. - If the intermittent is related to heat, review the data for a relationship with the following: High ambient temperatures - Underhood/engine generated heat - Circuit generated heat due to a poor connection, or high electrical load - Higher than normal load conditions, towing, etc. - If the intermittent is related to cold, review the data for the following: Low ambient temperatures-In extremely low temperatures, ice may form in a connection or component. Inspect for water intrusion. - The condition only occurs on a cold start. - The condition goes away when the vehicle warms up. - Information from the customer may help to determine if the trouble follows a pattern that is temperature related. - If temperature is suspected of causing an intermittent fault condition, attempt to duplicate the condition. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required. ELECTROMAGNETIC INTERFERENCE (EMI) AND ELECTRICAL NOISE Some electrical components/circuits are sensitive to electromagnetic interference (EMI) or other types of electrical noise. Inspect for the following conditions: A misrouted harness that is too close to high voltage/high current devices such as secondary ignition components, motors, generator etc-These components may induce electrical noise on a circuit that could interfere with normal circuit operation. - Electrical system interference caused by a malfunctioning relay, or a control module driven solenoid or switch-These conditions can cause a sharp electrical surge. Normally, the condition will occur when the malfunctioning component is operating. - Improper installation of non-factory or aftermarket add on accessories such as lights, 2-way radios, amplifiers, electric motors, remote starters, alarm systems, cell phones, etc-These accessories may lead to interference while in use, but do not fail when the accessories are not in use. - Test for an open diode across the A/C compressor clutch and for other open diodes. Some relays may contain a clamping diode. - The generator may be allowing AC noise into the electrical system. INCORRECT CONTROL MODULE - There are only a few situations where reprogramming a control module is appropriate: A new service control module is installed. Page 8304 2. Use a small flat-bladed tool to release the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting the tool in the small recess on the side of the connector and pushing up until the TPA releases from the connector body. The TPA should raise just slightly. Do not try to remove the TPA. IMPORTANT: The TPA on this connector cannot be removed unless the terminals are removed first. The TPA will come out of the connector body, but only slightly. When the TPA is slightly raised the terminals can be removed. Using excessive force to remove the TPA with the terminals still in the connector will damage the connector. 3. Repeat the process for the other side of the connector. 4. Ensure that the TPA is in the proper position to remove the terminals. Page 8467 Page 428 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert a small flat-blade tool in the slot below the front loaded terminal position assurance (TPA) and pry up. 3. Remove the TPA by pulling it out of the connector. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-553 (GM P/N 15315247) on a slight upward angle into the cavity below the terminal to be removed. Ensure that the pointed on the end of the tool is facing the bottom of the terminal and it stays in contact with the terminal until it stops on the plastic terminal retainer. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 5206 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry one side of the nose piece up to the pre-stage position. When the nose piece is in the pre-staged position, the nose piece will be raised above the connector body the length of the step in the nose piece. 7. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry the other side of the piece to the pre-stage position. If the nose piece is higher than the first step in the nose piece, gently push down on the nose piece until it meets with resistance from the connector body, you should feel the nose piece click into position. Page 45 Disclaimer Page 6833 1. Relieve the fuel system pressure, if required. Perform the following steps: Caution: Wrap a shop towel around the fuel pressure connection in order to reduce the risk of fire and personal injury. The towel will absorb any fuel leakage that occurs during the connection of the fuel pressure gage. Place the towel in an approved container when the connection of the fuel pressure gage is complete. 1. Wrap a shop towel around the fuel rail service port. 2. Place the hose on the CH-48027-2 (2) into an approved gasoline container. 3. Open the valve on the CH-48027-2 (2) in order to bleed any fuel from the fuel rail. 4. Close the valve on the CH-48027-2 (2). 5. Remove the hose on the CH-48027-2 (2) from the approved gasoline container. 6. Remove the shop towel from around the fuel rail service port, and place in an approved gasoline container. Notice: Clean all of the following areas before performing any disconnections in order to avoid possible contamination in the system: * The fuel pipe connections * The hose connections * The areas surrounding the connections Disconnect the CH-48027-1 (1) from the CH-48027-2 (2). 2. Disconnect the CH-48027-2 (2) from the CH-48027-3 (4). 3. Disconnect the CH-48027-3 (4) from the fuel rail service port. 4. Install the fuel rail service port cap. 5. Tighten the fuel fill cap. Page 1631 3. Ensure that the terminal release tang access panel is in the correct location to access the terminals. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) into the terminal release tang access slot located behind the access panel of the connector and press down on the terminal while carefully pulling the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Tyco/AMP Connectors (0.25 Cap) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (025 CAP) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component by pressing down on the connector position assurance (CPA). Page 674 Page 5356 5. While pushing the terminal forward, insert the J 38125-24 in the release cavity above the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (43-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Page 2017 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the rear TPA from the connector. 7. IMPORTANT: The front TPA cannot be removed from the connector. Only move it to the release point. Use a small flat-blade tool to move the front TPA to the release position. 8. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 9. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Molex Connectors Page 5659 All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system. Page 5947 Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested: - Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. - Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a component or to other harnesses. - If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A TEST LAMP TOOLS REQUIRED J 35616-200 Test Light - Probe Kit NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminate even though voltage is present. The J 35616-200 is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair of leads. To properly operate this tool use the following procedures. When testing for voltage: 1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested. When testing for ground: 1. Attach one lead to battery positive voltage. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where ground should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is ground at the point being tested. Using Connector Test Adapters USING CONNECTOR TEST ADAPTERS NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Using Fused Jumper Wires USING FUSED JUMPER WIRES TOOLS REQUIRED J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged. The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested. AFL/ECP Connectors AFL/EPC CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 6359 5. Once the nose piece retainers are relaxed, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should raise slightly. 6. On the opposite side of the nose piece, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should release completely. If the nose piece does not come off, repeat the procedure on the opposite side. Page 1761 9. The illustration shows a cutaway view of the connector to aid the technician in releasing the terminal retainer. 10. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Terminal Position Assurance Locks TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Tyco/Amp Connectors (CM 42-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (CM 42-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the connector body and pull the CPA out. The CPA is on the wire harness side of connector. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 7385 3. Remove the dress cover by using a flat-blade tool to release the connector locking tabs and pulling off the dress cover. 4. Relieve the tension on the nose piece retainers by inserting J-38125-12A (12094429) into the single retainer slot on the end of the nose piece and gently prying out the locking tab. Repeat the process for both of the nose piece locking tabs on the opposite side of the nose piece. Page 4035 2. Install the drive belt. Refer to Drive Belt Replacement - Accessory. Page 6185 Page 8272 pulling it through. This will prevent damage to the internal seals of the connector. Once the terminal is pushed out of the connector, cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible and pull the wire through the connector. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE The Micro-Pack 100W connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool was developed to crimp Micro-Pack 100W terminals. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 2. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert the terminal into the crimp tool until the core wings are flush with the anvil on the crimp tool. Be sure that the wings are pointed toward the crimp tool former and release the spring locator. The locator will hold the terminal in place. Inspect the alignment of the terminal wings with the crimp tool former. If the terminal wings are wider than the crimp tool former, remove the terminal and bend the terminal wings in slightly. 5. Place stripped wire into terminal. 6. Crimp the new terminal to the wire. If a jam occurs, press the emergency release to open applicator. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire perform the following procedure in order to replace Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. Page 2889 Disclaimer Page 2192 Page 1333 Connector Anatomy Connector Repairs contains a list of all connector repairs. The connector repairs are listed by the connector manufacturer and then by connector type. If the technician cannot identify the manufacturer of the connector, refer to Identifying Connectors below. Knowing the connector manufacturer will assist in finding the correct connector repair from the following list: - Connector Position Assurance Locks - Terminal Position Assurance Locks - Bosch Connectors (0.64) Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) Bosch Connectors (BSK) Bosch Connectors (ECM) - Delphi Connectors (Micro.64) Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) Delphi Connectors (12-Way) - Tyco/AMP Connectors (CM 42-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) Tyco/AMP Connectors (025 Cap) Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) - Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) - Repairing Connector Terminals IDENTIFYING CONNECTORS Knowing the connector manufacturer is helpful when trying to locating the correct connector repair procedure. There are many different connector designs used on GM vehicles and it is sometimes difficult to identify the connector manufacturer. The information in this document should help with the identification of connector manufactures. The following connector manufacturers make most of the connectors found in GM vehicles: AFL/EPC (Alcoa Fujikura Ltd./Engineered Plastics Components) - Bosch - Delphi - FCI (Framatome Connectors International) - JAE (Japan Aviation Electronics) - JST (Japan Solderless Terminals) Page 3611 onto the subject vehicle. - After match mounting, the tire/wheel assembly must be rebalanced. If match mounting tires to in-spec wheels produces assembly values higher than these, tire replacement may be necessary. Replacing tires at lower values will probably mean good tires are being condemned. Because tires can sometimes become temporarily flat-spotted, which will affect force variation, it is important that the vehicle be driven at least 16 km (10 mi) prior to measuring. Tire pressure must also be adjusted to the usage pressure on the vehicle's tire placard prior to measuring. Most GM vehicles will tolerate radial force variation up to these levels. However, some vehicles are more sensitive, and may require lower levels. Also, there are other tire parameters that equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700 cannot measure that may be a factor. In such cases, TAC should be contacted for further instructions. Important - When mounting a GM wheel to a wheel balancer/force variation machine, always use the wheel's center pilot hole. This is the primary centering mechanism on all GM wheels; the bolt holes are secondary. Usually a back cone method to the machine should be used. For added accuracy and repeatability, a flange plate should be used to clamp the wheel onto the cone and machine. This system is offered by all balancer manufacturers in GM's dealer program. - Any type of service equipment that removes tread rubber by grinding, buffing or truing is NOT recommended, and may void the tire warranty. However, tires may have been ground by the tire company as part of their tire manufacturing process. This is a legitimate procedure. Steering Wheel Shake Worksheet When diagnosing vibration concerns, use the following worksheet in conjunction with the appropriate Vibration Analysis-Road testing procedure in the Vibration Correction sub-section in SI. Page 7046 7. Apply pressure and gently rock the cover until one locking leg is unseated. 8. Continue to apply pressure and rock the cover until the second locking leg is unseated. Repeat procedure for the other side of the dress cover and remove the cover. 9. Use J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) to gently lift the terminal retaining tab while gently pulling the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 10. If the terminal is severely bent or damaged, it may be possible on some connectors to push the wire out of the front of the connector instead of Page 1408 7. Connect the MAF/IAT electrical connector. Page 7258 * Minimum pedal value-At key-up the engine control module (ECM) updates the learned minimum pedal value. * Minimum throttle position (TP) values-At key-up the ECM updates the learned minimum TP value. In order to learn the minimum TP value, the throttle blade is moved to the closed position. * Ice break mode-If the throttle is not able to reach a predetermined minimum throttle position, the ice break mode is entered. During the ice break mode, the ECM commands the maximum pulse width several times to the throttle actuator motor in the closing direction. * Battery saver mode-After a predetermined time without engine RPM, the ECM commands the battery saver mode. During the battery saver mode, the TAC module removes the voltage from the motor control circuits, which removes the current draw used to maintain the idle position and allows the throttle to return to the spring loaded default position. Reduced Engine Power Mode When the ECM detects a condition with the TAC system, the ECM may enter a reduced engine power mode. Reduced engine power may cause one or more of the following conditions: * Acceleration limiting-The ECM will continue to use the accelerator pedal for throttle control, however, the vehicle acceleration is limited. * Limited throttle mode-The ECM will continue to use the accelerator pedal for throttle control, however, the maximum throttle opening is limited. * Throttle default mode-The ECM will turn OFF the throttle actuator motor and the throttle will return to the spring loaded default position. * Forced idle mode-The ECM will perform the following actions: - Limit engine speed to idle by positioning the throttle position, or by controlling the fuel and spark if the throttle is turned OFF. - Ignore the accelerator pedal input. * Engine shutdown mode-The ECM will disable fuel and de-energize the throttle actuator. Page 5294 It is very important to use the correct test adapter when testing for proper terminal contact of fuses and relays in a bussed electrical center (BEC). Use J-35616-35 to test for proper terminal contact. Failure to use J-35616-35 can result in improper diagnosis of the BEC. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Separate the connector halves. 2. Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body. 3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J-38125 , test that the retention force is significantly different between a good terminal and a suspect terminal. Replace the female terminal in question. FLAT WIRE (DOCK AND LOCK) CONNECTORS There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock) connectors on the harness side or the component side. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Remove the component in question. 2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side of the connector as oil from your skin may be a source of contamination as well. 3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other imperfections that could cause poor terminal contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are uniform and free of damage or deformation. 4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the on the flat wire harness connector in order to test the circuit in question. CONTROL MODULE/COMPONENT VOLTAGE AND GROUNDS Poor voltage or ground connections can cause widely varying symptoms. Test all control module voltage supply circuits. Many vehicles have multiple circuits supplying voltage to a control module. Other components in the system may have separate voltage supply circuits that may also need to be tested. Inspect connections at the module/component connectors, fuses, and any intermediate connections between the voltage source and the module/component. A test lamp or a DMM may indicate that voltage is present, but neither tests the ability of the circuit to carry sufficient current. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Power Distribution Schematics. - Test all control module ground and system ground circuits. The control module may have multiple ground circuits. Other components in the system may have separate grounds that may also need to be tested. Inspect grounds for clean and tight connections at the grounding point. Inspect the connections at the component and in splice packs, where applicable. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Ground Distribution Schematics. TEMPERATURE SENSITIVITY - An intermittent condition may occur when a component/connection reaches normal operating temperature. The condition may occur only when the component/connection is cold, or only when the component/connection is hot. - Freeze Frame, Failure Records, Snapshot, or Vehicle Data Recorder data may help with this type of intermittent condition, where applicable. - If the intermittent is related to heat, review the data for a relationship with the following: High ambient temperatures - Underhood/engine generated heat - Circuit generated heat due to a poor connection, or high electrical load - Higher than normal load conditions, towing, etc. - If the intermittent is related to cold, review the data for the following: Low ambient temperatures-In extremely low temperatures, ice may form in a connection or component. Inspect for water intrusion. - The condition only occurs on a cold start. - The condition goes away when the vehicle warms up. - Information from the customer may help to determine if the trouble follows a pattern that is temperature related. - If temperature is suspected of causing an intermittent fault condition, attempt to duplicate the condition. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required. ELECTROMAGNETIC INTERFERENCE (EMI) AND ELECTRICAL NOISE Some electrical components/circuits are sensitive to electromagnetic interference (EMI) or other types of electrical noise. Inspect for the following conditions: A misrouted harness that is too close to high voltage/high current devices such as secondary ignition components, motors, generator etc-These components may induce electrical noise on a circuit that could interfere with normal circuit operation. - Electrical system interference caused by a malfunctioning relay, or a control module driven solenoid or switch-These conditions can cause a sharp electrical surge. Normally, the condition will occur when the malfunctioning component is operating. - Improper installation of non-factory or aftermarket add on accessories such as lights, 2-way radios, amplifiers, electric motors, remote starters, alarm systems, cell phones, etc-These accessories may lead to interference while in use, but do not fail when the accessories are not in use. - Test for an open diode across the A/C compressor clutch and for other open diodes. Some relays may contain a clamping diode. - The generator may be allowing AC noise into the electrical system. INCORRECT CONTROL MODULE - There are only a few situations where reprogramming a control module is appropriate: A new service control module is installed. Page 3689 Use extra care whenever towing another vehicle. Do not exceed the towing vehicle's gross combination weight (GCW) by adding the weight of the dinghy towed vehicle or vehicle damage may result. 6. When the vehicle being towed is firmly attached to the tow vehicle, release the parking brake. 7. Replace the fuse(s) in the fuse panel when finished towing. Tracker Models Note: Locking the steering column when towing your vehicle may damage the steering column. Always unlock the steering column before towing. Important: ^ Two-wheel drive Trackers cannot be dinghy towed. Two-wheel drive models MUST be towed with the rear drive wheels on a dolly. ^ The towing speed must not exceed 90 km/h (55 mph). In order to properly dinghy tow a 4WD Tracker, follow these steps: 1. Set the parking brake. 2. Shift the transmission into Park (AT) or second gear (MT). 3. With the ignition key in the ON position, move the transfer case to Neutral. Make sure the 4WD indicator on the instrument panel cluster is Off. 4. Turn the ignition key to ACC in order to unlock the steering wheel. 5. Release the parking brake. Stop towing the vehicle every 300 km (200 mi) and do the following steps: 1. Start the engine of the towed vehicle. 2. Leave the transfer case shift lever in Neutral. 3. Shift the transmission to Drive (AT). For vehicles with (MT), leave the transmission in second gear with the clutch engaged. 4. Run the engine at medium speed for one minute to circulate the oil through the transfer case. 2003-2007 Pontiac Vibe Only the front wheel drive vehicles with manual transmission are designed to be dinghy towed. Use the following procedure to properly dinghy tow these models: 1. Place the shift lever in Neutral. 2. Turn the ignition switch to the ACC position to avoid locking the steering wheel. Make sure that the audio system is turned off and that nothing is plugged into the power outlets. 3. Release the parking brake. 4. After dinghy towing the vehicle, let the engine idle for more than three minutes before driving the vehicle. Four Wheel Drive and All Wheel Drive Light Duty Trucks Page 2769 6. Remove the TCC PWM solenoid retainer (2) with a small screwdriver. Rotate the solenoid (1) in the bore, if necessary, until the flat part of the retainer (2) is visible. 7. Remove the TCC PWM solenoid (1) in order to access the TCC solenoid retaining bolts. 8. Remove the TCC solenoid retaining bolts. 9. Remove the TCC solenoid (with O-ring seal) and wiring harness from the control valve body. 10. Reposition the harness to the side of the transmission case. 11. Remove the control valve body bolts which retain the transmission fluid pressure switch to the control valve body. 12. Remove the transmission fluid pressure switch. Page 7333 If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200 DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J 39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected. IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J 39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and maximum (MAX) values measured. 1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of a suspected circuit to the other. 2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J 39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep). IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value in order to record the full change. 5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling the connections or the wiring, test driving, or performing other operations. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions. 6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9. Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist. Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections TESTING FOR INTERMITTENT CONDITIONS AND POOR CONNECTIONS TOOLS REQUIRED - J 35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit - J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit When the condition is not currently present, but is indicated in DTC history, the cause may be intermittent. An intermittent may also be the cause when there is a customer complaint, but the symptom cannot be duplicated. Refer to the Symptom Table of the system that is suspect of causing the condition before trying to locate an intermittent condition. Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the following items: Wiring broken inside the insulation - Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector - Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself, and corrosion in the wire to terminal contact area, etc. - Pierced or damaged insulation can allow moisture to enter the wiring causing corrosion. The conductor can corrode inside the insulation, with little visible evidence. Look for swollen and stiff sections of wire in the suspect circuits. - Wiring which has been pinched, cut, or its insulation rubbed through may cause an intermittent open or short as the bare area touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle. - Wiring that comes in contact with hot or exhaust components - Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required, in order to verify the customer concern. - Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. - Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis and Vehicle Data Recorder operation. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any inline connectors before replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation. Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination, usually in the underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit. Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper adapter. Always use the J 35616 when probing connectors. Other causes of terminal deformation are improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT IN BUSSED ELECTRICAL CENTERS (BEC) Page 6328 View of a typical Micro 64 connector. Depress the lock and pull the lever over and past the lock. Page 8978 11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the solder equipment. 12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. 13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to cover the first piece of tape. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE SLEEVES TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit IMPORTANT: Use only dura seal splice sleeves. Other splice sleeves may not protect the splice from moisture or provide a good electrical connection. Use duraseal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. Use duraseal splice sleeves where there is special requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire using duraseal splice sleeves. Page 6558 2. Locate the nose piece locking tabs that are positioned on the side of the connector nose piece. The connector nose piece acts as a terminal positive assurance (TPA) and may be referred to as such. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to push in one of the locking tabs while gently pulling on the same side of the nose piece. 4. Repeat the procedure for the other locking tab and remove the nose piece. 5. Remove the wire dress cover. The following is a general procedure for wire dress cover removal. Use this procedure as a guide, some dress cover removal procedures may vary. 6. Use fingers to squeeze the 2 locking legs of the cover. Page 406 View of typical connector. View of connector in released position. 1. Locate the assist lever at the back of the connector. Move the assist lever to the rear position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the dress cover. Page 909 Page 5641 Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under the 5 year / 100,000 mile (160,000 km) emission warranty, use: Warranty Information (Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 2490 4. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the rear of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. 5. Once the locking tabs are unlocked, slide the inner connector out of the rear of the connector housing. Page 6664 It is very important to use the correct test adapter when testing for proper terminal contact of fuses and relays in a bussed electrical center (BEC). Use J-35616-35 to test for proper terminal contact. Failure to use J-35616-35 can result in improper diagnosis of the BEC. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Separate the connector halves. 2. Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body. 3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J-38125 , test that the retention force is significantly different between a good terminal and a suspect terminal. Replace the female terminal in question. FLAT WIRE (DOCK AND LOCK) CONNECTORS There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock) connectors on the harness side or the component side. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Remove the component in question. 2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side of the connector as oil from your skin may be a source of contamination as well. 3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other imperfections that could cause poor terminal contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are uniform and free of damage or deformation. 4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the on the flat wire harness connector in order to test the circuit in question. CONTROL MODULE/COMPONENT VOLTAGE AND GROUNDS Poor voltage or ground connections can cause widely varying symptoms. Test all control module voltage supply circuits. Many vehicles have multiple circuits supplying voltage to a control module. Other components in the system may have separate voltage supply circuits that may also need to be tested. Inspect connections at the module/component connectors, fuses, and any intermediate connections between the voltage source and the module/component. A test lamp or a DMM may indicate that voltage is present, but neither tests the ability of the circuit to carry sufficient current. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Power Distribution Schematics. - Test all control module ground and system ground circuits. The control module may have multiple ground circuits. Other components in the system may have separate grounds that may also need to be tested. Inspect grounds for clean and tight connections at the grounding point. Inspect the connections at the component and in splice packs, where applicable. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Ground Distribution Schematics. TEMPERATURE SENSITIVITY - An intermittent condition may occur when a component/connection reaches normal operating temperature. The condition may occur only when the component/connection is cold, or only when the component/connection is hot. - Freeze Frame, Failure Records, Snapshot, or Vehicle Data Recorder data may help with this type of intermittent condition, where applicable. - If the intermittent is related to heat, review the data for a relationship with the following: High ambient temperatures - Underhood/engine generated heat - Circuit generated heat due to a poor connection, or high electrical load - Higher than normal load conditions, towing, etc. - If the intermittent is related to cold, review the data for the following: Low ambient temperatures-In extremely low temperatures, ice may form in a connection or component. Inspect for water intrusion. - The condition only occurs on a cold start. - The condition goes away when the vehicle warms up. - Information from the customer may help to determine if the trouble follows a pattern that is temperature related. - If temperature is suspected of causing an intermittent fault condition, attempt to duplicate the condition. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required. ELECTROMAGNETIC INTERFERENCE (EMI) AND ELECTRICAL NOISE Some electrical components/circuits are sensitive to electromagnetic interference (EMI) or other types of electrical noise. Inspect for the following conditions: A misrouted harness that is too close to high voltage/high current devices such as secondary ignition components, motors, generator etc-These components may induce electrical noise on a circuit that could interfere with normal circuit operation. - Electrical system interference caused by a malfunctioning relay, or a control module driven solenoid or switch-These conditions can cause a sharp electrical surge. Normally, the condition will occur when the malfunctioning component is operating. - Improper installation of non-factory or aftermarket add on accessories such as lights, 2-way radios, amplifiers, electric motors, remote starters, alarm systems, cell phones, etc-These accessories may lead to interference while in use, but do not fail when the accessories are not in use. - Test for an open diode across the A/C compressor clutch and for other open diodes. Some relays may contain a clamping diode. - The generator may be allowing AC noise into the electrical system. INCORRECT CONTROL MODULE - There are only a few situations where reprogramming a control module is appropriate: A new service control module is installed. Page 1784 If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the DuraSeal splice sleeves. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: - Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. - Do not use the crimp and DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 to crimp DuraSeal splice sleeve. In order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 3178 Installation Procedure 1. Wipe the excess oil from the oil filter mounting. 2. Lubricate the oil filter seal with clean engine oil. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 3. Install the oil filter to the oil pan. Tighten the filter to 30 N.m (22 lb ft). 4. Wipe the excess oil from the drain plug hole. 5. Install the oil drain plug to the oil pan. Tighten the oil pan drain plug to 25 N.m (18 lb ft). Page 6941 3. Ensure that the terminal release tang access panel is in the correct location to access the terminals. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) into the terminal release tang access slot located behind the access panel of the connector and press down on the terminal while carefully pulling the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Tyco/AMP Connectors (0.25 Cap) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (025 CAP) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component by pressing down on the connector position assurance (CPA). Page 3285 4. Slide the dress cover forward and off of the connector. 5. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front and rear of the connector. Page 1443 IMPORTANT: Ensure that the dress cover and connector body are both in the released position before reassembling. Failure to do so may cause damage to the connector and component. Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (0.64) BOSCH CONNECTORS (0.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While pressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock until the lever is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Pull the rubber boot that covers the wires back to expose the end of the connector dress cover. 4. Place the connector locking lever in the center of the connector. 5. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs that are on the wire end of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover and connector body and pry up. Page 7430 Engine Control Module: Service Precautions Powertrain Control Module and Electrostatic Discharge Notice Notice: Do not touch the connector pins or soldered components on the circuit board in order to prevent possible electrostatic discharge (ESD) damage to the PCM. Page 7207 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 1521 Important: Before installing the camshaft sensor assembly, apply a small amount of clean motor oil to the O-ring (6). 4. Install the camshaft position sensor assembly (4, 5, 6) in the front cover (7). Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 5. Install the camshaft position sensor mounting bolts. Tighten the camshaft position mounting bolts 25 N.m (18 lb ft). 6. Install the generator assembly. Page 7920 Important The following information MUST be documented on the repair order. Failure to do so may result in a chargeback. - Customer vehicle condition. - Was a Service Lamp or Service Message illuminated? If yes, specify which Service Lamp or Service Message. - Was a DTC(s) set? If yes, specify which DTC(s) were set. - After following the procedure contained within this bulletin, could the condition be duplicated? ‹› If the condition was not duplicated, then document the affected module/component connector name and number on the repair order. - If the condition was duplicated after the procedure contained within this bulletin was followed, and additional diagnosis led to the replacement of a module or component, the SI Document ID Number MUST be written on the repair order. Parts Information Alternate Distributor For All of North America Note NyoGel(R) 760G Lubricant* is equivalent to GMSPO P/N 12377900, and P/N 10953529 (Canada), specified for use to correct the condition in this bulletin. *We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may be available from other sources. Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to: Warranty Information (Saab Models) Page 7012 vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide variety of actions, including: - Wiggling the harness - Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting - Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector - Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation - Relocating a harness or wires All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. Another option is, with the component commanded ON and OFF by the scan tool, move related connectors and wiring and observe the component operation. With the engine running, move related connectors and wiring while monitoring engine operation. If harness or connector movement affects the data displayed, component/system operation, or engine operation, inspect and repair the harness/connections as necessary. You may need to load the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these cases you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide good results as well. There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions, along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the circuit to these kinds of conditions. SALT WATER SPRAY Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture. Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5 percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously. HIGH TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070. Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault condition. The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis. This option does not allow for the same control, however. LOW TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect. If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to -18°C (0°F) from one end and +71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized cooling needs. Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or components in an effort to duplicate the concern. DUPLICATING FAILURE CONDITIONS - If none of the previous tests are successful, attempt to duplicate and/or capture the failure conditions. Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, where applicable, contains the conditions that were present when the DTC set. 1. Review and record Freeze Frame/Failure Records data. 2. Clear the DTCs using the scan tool. 3. Turn the key to OFF and wait 15 seconds. 4. Operate the vehicle under the same conditions that were noted in Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, as closely as possible. The vehicle must also be operating within the Conditions for Running the DTC. Refer to Conditions for Running the DTC in the supporting text if a DTC is being diagnosed. 5. Monitor DTC Status for the DTC being tested. The scan tool will indicate Ran, when the enabling conditions have been satisfied long enough for the DTC to run. The scan tool will also indicate whether the DTC passed or failed. - An alternate method is to drive the vehicle with the DMM connected to a suspected circuit. An abnormal reading on the DMM when the concern occurs, may help you locate the concern. Measuring Frequency Page 8060 breakers are used. CIRCUIT BREAKER This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high current is removed. POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) CIRCUIT BREAKER This type greatly increases its resistance when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker will re-close within a second or 2. Circuit Protection - Fuses CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSES The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and examine the element in the fuse for an open (2). If not broken (1), also check for continuity using a DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one of equal current rating. Circuit Protection - Fusible Links CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSIBLE LINKS Page 2279 If a wire is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm, etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except coaxial. - Do not use the DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent American wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 6475 2. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 1751 4. Slide the dress cover forward and off of the connector. 5. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front and rear of the connector. Page 1313 MEASURING FREQUENCY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal. IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM to autorange to an appropriate range. 1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency measured. Measuring Voltage MEASURING VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit. 1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods: - Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. - Turn ON the engine. - Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls. - Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested. 3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The DMM displays the voltage measured at that point. Measuring Voltage Drop MEASURING VOLTAGE DROP NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points. Probing Electrical Connectors PROBING ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS Page 7087 breakers are used. CIRCUIT BREAKER This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high current is removed. POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) CIRCUIT BREAKER This type greatly increases its resistance when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker will re-close within a second or 2. Circuit Protection - Fuses CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSES The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and examine the element in the fuse for an open (2). If not broken (1), also check for continuity using a DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one of equal current rating. Circuit Protection - Fusible Links CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSIBLE LINKS Page 7554 11. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 12. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 13. Center the high temperature SCT1 shrink tube over the DuraSeal splice sleeve. 14. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the high temperature heat shrink tubing. 15. Gradually move the heat from the center to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 16. Replace any reflective tape and clips that may have been remove during the repair. Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation REPAIRING DAMAGED WIRE INSULATION Wire Size Conversion Page 7026 difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Bosch Connectors (ECM) BOSCH CONNECTORS (ECM) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the assist lever on the top of the connector. Move the assist lever to the forward position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 347 Page 5213 3. Use a small flat-bladed tool to gently pry off the dress cover by inserting the tool under the cover opposite the harness side and prying up. 4. Remove the cover. 5. Using a small flat-bladed tool, push on the side of the nose piece retainer while pushing the nose piece forward with your thumb. This will release the terminal position assurance (TPA). 6. Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) into the corresponding terminal release cavity. The release cavities are the 2 center rows of cavities on one half of the connector. Page 4605 11. Insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) into the 2 triangular cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 12. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE 1. Prior to installation the terminal must be aligned so the (1) coding lugs align with the (2) coding grooves on the connector. 2. Once the terminal is aligned, slide the terminal into the cavity until the retainer has engaged in the cavity of the connector. 3. Slide the TPA in the connector body and seat it using a small flat bladed tool. The TPA is seated when it is flush with the contact housing. 4. Secure the wires to the connector body using a tie wrap and replace the dress cover and grommet. Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) BOSCH CONNECTORS (2.8 JPT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Pull out the slider on the connector position assurance (CPA) until it is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Specifications Axle Nut: Specifications Tighten the wheel hub and bearing mounting bolts to ............................................................................................................................... 105 N.m (77 lb ft). Page 8079 Engine Control Module (ECM) C1 (Pin 1 To 15) Page 4957 Release the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the blue locking tabs on both ends of the connector. Gently slide the TPA up to the released position on both ends. 6. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-13A (GM P/N 12031876-1) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. Page 7627 - Kostel - Molex - Sumitomo - Tyco/AMP - Yazaki Identifying the manufacturer of a connector is often difficult. When trying to determine the manufacturer of a connector, look for specific identifying marks that are unique to that connector supplier. Most of these identify marks are hard to find or see. Check the connector carefully and refer to the information below for pictures and descriptions of connector identification markings. - Most of AFLs connectors have EPC on their connector body. Some of the smaller connectors will not have any markings on them. - In some cases Bosch will actually be printed on the connector. If Bosch does not appear on the connector, look for the Bosch logo. The Bosch logo is a circle with a blunted arrow inside. This logo can appear anywhere on the connector and is often very small. Page 1994 View of the connector when released from the component. View of another type of Micro 64 connector. Page 7621 5. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove TPA from the connector. 6. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Page 4161 1. Apply sealant to the threads of the oil pressure sensor. Refer to Sealers, Adhesives, and Lubricants for the correct part number. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Using J 41712 or equivalent, install the oil pressure sensor. Tighten the sensor to 35 N.m (26 lb ft). 3. Connect the oil pressure sensor electrical connector (1). 4. Install the intake manifold. Refer to Intake Manifold Replacement. Page 7104 Heated Oxygen Sensor Replacement - Bank 1 Sensor 1 Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Heated Oxygen Sensor Replacement - Bank 1 Sensor 1 Heated Oxygen Sensor Replacement - Bank 1 Sensor 1 Removal Procedure Notice: Refer to Heated Oxygen and Oxygen Sensor Notice. Notice: Refer to Excessive Force and Oxygen Sensor Notice. 1. Raise and suitably support the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Unscrew the heated oxygen sensor (HO2S) sensor from the catalytic converter. 3. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) retainer. 4. Disconnect the HO2S electrical connector (3). Installation Procedure Page 540 2. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully push the terminal position assurance (TPA) towards the face of the connector on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA is fragile and may break if not done carefully. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. 3. Use the J 38125-215 tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 9061 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry one side of the nose piece up to the pre-stage position. When the nose piece is in the pre-staged position, the nose piece will be raised above the connector body the length of the step in the nose piece. 7. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry the other side of the piece to the pre-stage position. If the nose piece is higher than the first step in the nose piece, gently push down on the nose piece until it meets with resistance from the connector body, you should feel the nose piece click into position. HVAC - Automatic Low Pressure Sensor / Switch: Diagrams HVAC - Automatic HVAC Connector End Views A/C Low Pressure Switch Reverse Lockout Solenoid Page 710 Depress the locks that are located on both sides of the wiredress cover and pull the lever over and past the locks. View of the connector when released from the component. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the front of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool push down on one of the locking tabs and pull the cover up until the dress cover releases. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. Diagram Information and Instructions Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions Electrical Symbols Page 7220 Release the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the blue locking tabs on both ends of the connector. Gently slide the TPA up to the released position on both ends. 6. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-13A (GM P/N 12031876-1) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. Page 8750 Oxygen Sensor: Service Precautions Excessive Force and Oxygen Sensor Notice Excessive Force and Oxygen Sensor Notice Notice: The oxygen sensor may be difficult to remove when the engine temperature is below 48°C (120°F). Excessive force may damage threads in the exhaust manifold or the exhaust pipe. Page 6121 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 4515 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) and slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. Page 8030 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. JST Connectors JST CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, remove the connector from the component. Page 5528 Refer to the following table as a guide in selecting the correct test adapter for front probing connectors: Backprobe IMPORTANT: Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures. - Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector. - Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large of a test probe. - After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected, test for proper terminal contact. Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the connector. Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure SCAN TOOL SNAPSHOT PROCEDURE Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used Page 7303 8. Take a CLEAR digital picture of the Tech 2(R) Vehicle Information screen showing the engine Calibration IDs and Verification Numbers as shown above. Retain the printout information and the Tech 2(R) screen photograph with the repair order. Note All pictures must be sent as a.jpg file. 9. E-mail a copy of the picture to [email protected]. In the subject line of the e-mail include the phrase "V8 Cal" as well as the complete VIN and Dealer BAC. In the body of the e-mail, include the VIN, mileage, R.O. number and BAC. Include a brief description of the customer concern and cause of the concern. Note The dealer will receive an e-mail reply after the calibrations have been validated. The e-mail reply will advise the dealer if the calibrations are OEM. 10. Allow two hours for the PQC to verify the calibrations and set up the case details. ‹› If the PQC determines that the calibrations ARE aftermarket calibrations, DO NOT contact GM Technical Assistance to discuss warranty concerns on the aftermarket calibrations. ALL questions and concerns about warranty should be directed to the dealers Fixed Operations Manager (FOM), (Warranty Manager (WM) in Canada). 11. You may call the PQC two hours after submitting the e-mail for authorization to replace the assembly. This will provide them time to receive, review and set up a case on the request. Please be prepared to provide all the usual documentation that is normally required when requesting an assembly authorization from the PQC. Tech 2(R) Displaying All Zeroes for the Verification Numbers on the Calibration ID and Verification Number Screen If the Tech 2(R) that you are using displays all zeroes for the Verification Numbers as shown, then perform the following steps: 1. Update the Tech 2(R) with the latest software from TIS2WEB. 2. Turn OFF the ignition for 90 seconds. 3. Connect the Tech 2(R) to the vehicle. 4. Turn ON the ignition, and build the vehicle. Observe the Tech 2(R) Calibration ID and Verification Number screen for proper operation. ‹› If the Tech 2(R) screen still does not display properly, then turn OFF the ignition for 90 seconds again. Turn ON the ignition and observe the same screen for proper operation. Retrieving Calibrations From a Global A Vehicle This information applies to the 2010 Camaro and is typical of the procedure that will be used on Global A vehicles. 1. Turn OFF the ignition. Page 1928 6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias. Reference the appropriate service manual wiring schematic to obtain the correct diode installation position. 7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for the soldering equipment. 8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed. 9. IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode attachment points with tape. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape. Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable SPLICING TWISTED OR SHIELDED CABLE Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable. 1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splice is made. 3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire. Staggering the splices by 65 mm (2.5 in) is recommended. 4. IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical contact with the drain wire. Re-assemble the cable. Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape. - Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1). - Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire. - Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape. Page 8516 to analyze the data during the time a vehicle condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a trigger point that you have determined. Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2 snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a first-in, first-out basis. If a third snapshot is taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost. Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types: Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice - Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200 frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not lost if the Scan Tool is powered down. The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis. The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected values by plotting 3 parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful, especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC. Testing for a Short to Voltage TESTING FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4. Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt, there is a short to voltage in the circuit. Testing for Continuity TESTING FOR CONTINUITY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6. Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit. 7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity. With a Test Lamp IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits. 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6. If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity. Testing for Electrical Intermittents TESTING FOR ELECTRICAL INTERMITTENTS Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment. - Testing for Short to Ground - Testing for Continuity - Testing for a Short to Voltage Page 2851 Alignment: Description and Operation Caster Description Caster Description Caster Description Caster is the tilting of the uppermost point of the steering axis either forward or backward, when viewed from the side of the vehicle. A backward tilt is positive (+) and a forward tilt is negative (-). Caster influences directional control of the steering but does not affect the tire wear. Caster is affected by the vehicle height, therefore it is important to keep the body at its designed height. Overloading the vehicle or a weak or sagging rear spring will affect caster. When the rear of the vehicle is lower than its designated trim height, the front suspension moves to a more positive caster. If the rear of the vehicle is higher than its designated trim height, the front suspension moves to a less positive caster. With too little positive caster, steering may be touchy at high speed and wheel returnability may be diminished when coming out of a turn. If one wheel has more positive caster than the other, that wheel will pull toward the center of the vehicle. This condition will cause the vehicle to pull or lead to the side with the least amount of positive caster. Camber Description Camber Description Camber Description Camber is the tilting of the wheels from the vertical when viewed from the front of the vehicle. When the wheels tilt outward at the top, the camber is positive (+). When the wheel tilts inward at the top, the camber is negative (-). The amount of tilt is measured in degrees from the vertical. Camber settings influence the directional control and the tire wear. Too much positive camber will result in premature wear on the outside of the tire and cause excessive wear on the suspension parts. Too much negative camber will result in premature wear on the inside of the tire and cause excessive wear on the suspension parts. Unequal side-to-side camber of 1 degree or more will cause the vehicle to pull or lead to the side with the most positive camber. Toe Description Toe Description Page 8303 3. Ensure that the terminal release tang access panel is in the correct location to access the terminals. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) into the terminal release tang access slot located behind the access panel of the connector and press down on the terminal while carefully pulling the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Tyco/AMP Connectors (0.25 Cap) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (025 CAP) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component by pressing down on the connector position assurance (CPA). Page 6368 2. Use a small flat-bladed tool to release the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting the tool in the small recess on the side of the connector and pushing up until the TPA releases from the connector body. The TPA should raise just slightly. Do not try to remove the TPA. IMPORTANT: The TPA on this connector cannot be removed unless the terminals are removed first. The TPA will come out of the connector body, but only slightly. When the TPA is slightly raised the terminals can be removed. Using excessive force to remove the TPA with the terminals still in the connector will damage the connector. 3. Repeat the process for the other side of the connector. 4. Ensure that the TPA is in the proper position to remove the terminals. Page 6108 REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. The release tab is located on the top of the wiredress cover. View of connector in released position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Locations Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Locations Engine Controls Component Views Upper Right Side of the Engine - Front 1 - Engine 2 - Engine Harness 3 - Air Duct 4 - Mass Air Flow (MAF)/Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor Page 1374 7. Pressing the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool in the release cavity of the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and crimper in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (DOOR MODULE) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Side view of connector. View of top of connector. 1. Locate the assist lever and lock on the top of the connector. Page 361 to analyze the data during the time a vehicle condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a trigger point that you have determined. Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2 snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a first-in, first-out basis. If a third snapshot is taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost. Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types: Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice - Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200 frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not lost if the Scan Tool is powered down. The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis. The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected values by plotting 3 parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful, especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC. Testing for a Short to Voltage TESTING FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4. Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt, there is a short to voltage in the circuit. Testing for Continuity TESTING FOR CONTINUITY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6. Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit. 7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity. With a Test Lamp IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits. 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6. If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity. Testing for Electrical Intermittents TESTING FOR ELECTRICAL INTERMITTENTS Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment. - Testing for Short to Ground - Testing for Continuity - Testing for a Short to Voltage Page 5097 results from the alteration or modification of a vehicle using non-GM approved parts or accessories. Dealers should be especially cautious of accessory companies that claim the installation of their product will not void the factory warranty. Many times these companies have even given direction on how to quickly disassemble the accessory in an attempt to preclude the manufacturer from finding out that is has been installed. Any suspect repairs should be reviewed by the Fixed Operations Manager (FOM), and in Canada by the Warranty Manager (WM) for appropriate repair direction. If it is decided that a goodwill repair is to be made on the vehicle, even with the installation of such non-GM approved components, the customer is to be made aware of General Motors position on this issue and is to sign the appropriate goodwill documentation required by General Motors. It is imperative for dealers to understand that by installing such devices, they are jeopardizing not only the warranty coverage, but also the performance and reliability of the customer's vehicle. Disclaimer Page 1997 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert terminal into the appropriate terminal holder until it hits bottom and stops. The correct terminal holder is determined by the wire size. Also ensure that the terminals wings are pointing towards the former on the tool and the release locator. 5. Insert the stripped cable into the terminal. Insulation should be visible on both sides of the terminal insulation wings. 6. Compress the handles until the ratchet automatically releases. 7. Place the terminal into the appropriate cavity and assemble the connector. Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO-PACK 100W) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W connectors. These connectors are very similar but use different terminals and have some minor physical differences also. Page 413 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 6000 3. Use a small flat-bladed tool to gently pry off the dress cover by inserting the tool under the cover opposite the harness side and prying up. 4. Remove the cover. 5. Using a small flat-bladed tool, push on the side of the nose piece retainer while pushing the nose piece forward with your thumb. This will release the terminal position assurance (TPA). 6. Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) into the corresponding terminal release cavity. The release cavities are the 2 center rows of cavities on one half of the connector. Page 7212 3. Use a small flat-bladed tool to gently pry off the dress cover by inserting the tool under the cover opposite the harness side and prying up. 4. Remove the cover. 5. Using a small flat-bladed tool, push on the side of the nose piece retainer while pushing the nose piece forward with your thumb. This will release the terminal position assurance (TPA). 6. Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) into the corresponding terminal release cavity. The release cavities are the 2 center rows of cavities on one half of the connector. Page 5336 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Kostal Connectors KOSTAL CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 8428 MOLEX CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. 2. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. Page 511 4. Use a small flat-blade tool to slide the terminal position assurance (TPA) up one notch on both ends of the connector. The TPA is located underneath the wire dress cover. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 7674 Release the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the blue locking tabs on both ends of the connector. Gently slide the TPA up to the released position on both ends. 6. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-13A (GM P/N 12031876-1) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. Page 6963 6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias. Reference the appropriate service manual wiring schematic to obtain the correct diode installation position. 7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for the soldering equipment. 8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed. 9. IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode attachment points with tape. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape. Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable SPLICING TWISTED OR SHIELDED CABLE Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable. 1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splice is made. 3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire. Staggering the splices by 65 mm (2.5 in) is recommended. 4. IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical contact with the drain wire. Re-assemble the cable. Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape. - Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1). - Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire. - Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape. Catalytic Converter Heat Shield Replacement Heat Shield: Service and Repair Catalytic Converter Heat Shield Replacement Catalytic Converter Heat Shield Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 2. Remove the 5 bolts securing the heat shield to the floor panel studs. 3. Remove the heat shield from the vehicle. Installation Procedure 1. Place the catalytic converter heat shield onto the floor panel studs. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Secure the heat shield with the 5 bolts. Tighten the catalytic converter heat shield bolts to 7 N.m (62 lb in). 3. Lower the vehicle. Page 7181 4. Once the front 2 locks are unlocked, lift the front of the dress cover and pull it forward. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the small slot on the TPA and pushing down until the TPA releases. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to angle or rock the J 38125-21 tool when inserting it into the connector or the tool may break. Insert the J 38125-21 (GM P/N 15381651-2) tool into the round canal between the terminals cavities at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to repair Micro 64 connector terminals. The Micro 64 connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-64 (M jaw) was developed to crimp Micro 64 terminals. The J 38125-64 crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. The J 38125-64 crimping tool is also designed to crimp both the wire and the insulation at the same time. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro 64 terminals. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. 1. Cut the wire as close to the damaged terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. Page 4489 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (BSK) BOSCH CONNECTORS (BSK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 3. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 4. Insert the J 38125-561 tool into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 5. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is Page 7305 Note All pictures must be sent as a.jpg file. 27. E-mail a copy of the screenshot to [email protected]. In the subject line of the e-mail include the phrase "V8 Cal" as well as the complete VIN and Dealer BAC. In the body of the e-mail, include the VIN, mileage, R.O. number and BAC. Include a brief description of the customer concern and cause of the concern. Note The dealer will receive an e-mail reply after the calibrations have been validated. The e-mail reply will advise the dealer if the calibrations are OEM. 28. Allow two hours for the PQC to verify the calibrations and set up the case details. ‹› If the PQC determines that the calibrations ARE aftermarket calibrations, DO NOT contact GM Technical Assistance to discuss warranty concerns on the aftermarket calibrations. ALL questions and concerns about warranty should be directed to the dealers Fixed Operations Manager (FOM), (Warranty Manager (WM) in Canada). 29. You may call the PQC two hours after submitting the e-mail for authorization to replace the assembly. This will provide them time to receive, review and set up a case on the request. Please be prepared to provide all the usual documentation that is normally required when requesting an assembly authorization from the PQC. Warranty Information - The Dealership Service Management must be involved in any situation that would justify the use of labor operation Z1111. - Notify the Fixed Operations Manager (FOM) (Warranty Manager (WM) in Canada) of the situation. - All claims will have to be routed to the FOM (WM in Canada) for approval. - Please refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 09-00-89-016, Labor Operation Z1111 - Suspected Tampering or Vehicle Modifications for important information. For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 7521 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Kostal Connectors KOSTAL CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 4743 1. Install the radiator. 2. Install the condenser to the radiator retaining tab. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 3. Install the bolts retaining the condenser to the radiator. Tighten the bolts to 28 N.m (21 lb ft). 4. Install the coolant recovery line to the radiator. 5. Install the air inlet grille. Refer to Air Inlet Grille Panel Replacement (Envoy, TrailBlazer) Air Inlet Grille Panel Replacement (Rainier). 6. Install the cooling fan and shroud. Refer to Cooling Fan and Shroud Replacement. Page 892 breakers are used. CIRCUIT BREAKER This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high current is removed. POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) CIRCUIT BREAKER This type greatly increases its resistance when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker will re-close within a second or 2. Circuit Protection - Fuses CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSES The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and examine the element in the fuse for an open (2). If not broken (1), also check for continuity using a DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one of equal current rating. Circuit Protection - Fusible Links CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSIBLE LINKS Page 2347 7. Apply pressure and gently rock the cover until one locking leg is unseated. 8. Continue to apply pressure and rock the cover until the second locking leg is unseated. Repeat procedure for the other side of the dress cover and remove the cover. 9. Use J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) to gently lift the terminal retaining tab while gently pulling the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 10. If the terminal is severely bent or damaged, it may be possible on some connectors to push the wire out of the front of the connector instead of Page 1718 IMPORTANT: Ensure that the dress cover and connector body are both in the released position before reassembling. Failure to do so may cause damage to the connector and component. Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (0.64) BOSCH CONNECTORS (0.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While pressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock until the lever is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Pull the rubber boot that covers the wires back to expose the end of the connector dress cover. 4. Place the connector locking lever in the center of the connector. 5. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs that are on the wire end of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover and connector body and pry up. Page 15 Notice: In order to avoid damage to the circuit board, do NOT over-tighten the thumb screws. Using your fingers, apply only a light pressure. 3. Connect the 2 electrical connectors. Tighten the module thumb screw to a maximum of 0.2 N.m (2 lb in). 4. Install the protective cover to the module. 5. Position the right rear seat bottom to a passenger position. Important: After replacing the vehicle communication interface module, you must reconfigure the OnStar(R) system. Failure to reconfigure the system will result in an additional customer visit for repair. In addition, pressing and holding the white dot button on the keypad will NOT reset this version of the OnStar(R) system. This action will cause a DTC to set. 6. Install the scan tool. Use the special functions menu in order to perform the OnStar(R) setup procedure for this vehicle. 7. Move the vehicle to an open area that is away from tall buildings and with a clear view of unobstructed sky. Allow the vehicle to run for 10 minutes. 8. Use the ID information menu on the scan tool to access the new station ID (STID) and the electronic serial number (ESN) from the new VCIM. 9. Press the blue OnStar(R) button to connect to the OnStar(R) Call Center and perform the following procedure: 1. Tell the advisor that this vehicle has received a new VCIM. 2. Ask the advisor to add the new STID and the ESN to update the customer's account. 3. Follow any additional instructions from the OnStar(R) advisor. 4. Ask the advisor to activate the OnStar(R) Personal Calling feature, if available. Page 7344 5. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove TPA from the connector. 6. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Page 8616 1. Install the MAP sensor (1). Push the MAP sensor into the intake manifold. 2. Install the MAP sensor retainer (2) to the intake manifold. 3. Connect the MAP sensor electrical connector (3). Page 7148 Page 8590 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Start in the middle and gradually move the heat barrel to the open ends of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Heated Oxygen Sensor Wiring Repairs HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being obstructed. If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. - Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks, etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire. - Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance. - To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector. Page 3059 12. Install the power steering return hose and the power steering cooler hose to the power steering cooler. 13. Connect the power steering hose assembly (1) to the power steering gear (3). 14. Install the power steering hose assembly to the power steering gear with the mounting bolt (2). Tighten the bolt to 12 N.m (106 lb in). 15. Remove the drain pan from under the vehicle. 16. Lower the vehicle. 17. Bleed the power steering system. Refer to Power Steering System Bleeding. Page 2692 Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Install the seat position switch (3) to the seat adjuster (2) with 2 nuts (1). Tighten the seat position switch nuts to 24 N.m (18 lb ft). 3. Install the seat adjusters to the seat cushion frame with 4 nuts (1). Tighten the seat cushion frame mounting nuts to 24 N.m (18 lb ft). 4. Install the assist spring. Page 1453 View of a typical Micro 64 connector. Depress the lock and pull the lever over and past the lock. Page 7241 US English/Metric Conversion US English/Metric Conversion Page 8743 Page 4890 IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals. Front probe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the connector. IMPORTANT: When probing female 0.64 terminals, it is important to use the correct adapter. There have been some revisions to the test adapter for 0.64 terminals. The proper adapter for 0.64 terminals is the J 35616-64B which has a gold terminal and a black wire between the base and tip. Failure to use the proper test adapter may result in damage to the terminal being tested and improper diagnosis. NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Page 8257 5. Insert the J 38125-557 (GM P/N 12122378) into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 6. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Connector Position Assurance Locks CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of the connector. CPAs are used in various connectors throughout the vehicle. CPAs are also used in all SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals, of the connector. Connector Repairs CONNECTOR REPAIRS Page 4859 11. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 12. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 13. Center the high temperature SCT1 shrink tube over the DuraSeal splice sleeve. 14. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the high temperature heat shrink tubing. 15. Gradually move the heat from the center to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 16. Replace any reflective tape and clips that may have been remove during the repair. Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation REPAIRING DAMAGED WIRE INSULATION Wire Size Conversion Page 5816 5. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove TPA from the connector. 6. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Page 5532 - A control module from another vehicle is installed. - Revised software/calibration files have been released for this vehicle. - IMPORTANT: DO NOT re-program the control module with the SAME software/calibration files that are already present in the control module. This is not an effective repair for any type of concern. Verify that the control module contains the correct software/calibration. If incorrect programming is found, reprogram the control module with the most current software/calibration. Refer to Control Module References for replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Testing for Short to Ground TESTING FOR SHORT TO GROUND NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 4. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit. With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is a short to ground in the circuit. Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2. Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). - When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. - If the DMM does not display voltage 4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is shorted. Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A DIGITAL MULTIMETER NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the powertrain control module (PCM), should only be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200 Digital Multimeter (DMM). The J 39200 instruction manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminage even though voltage is present. The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity. IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading. Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the measurement. Page 8053 5. While pushing the terminal forward, insert the J 38125-24 in the release cavity above the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (43-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Page 2127 The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors. 1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position. 4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool J 38125-10A (GM P/N 12014012-1) into the front (mating end) of the connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal through the back of the connector (2). IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector. 6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. 7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily. 10. Perform system check. Delphi Connectors (12 Way) DELPHI CONNECTORS (12-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. Page 5643 Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Locations Engine Controls Component Views Left Side of Engine - Front 1 - Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor 2 - G108 Page 104 Page 6729 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert a small flat-blade tool in the slot below the front loaded terminal position assurance (TPA) and pry up. 3. Remove the TPA by pulling it out of the connector. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-553 (GM P/N 15315247) on a slight upward angle into the cavity below the terminal to be removed. Ensure that the pointed on the end of the tool is facing the bottom of the terminal and it stays in contact with the terminal until it stops on the plastic terminal retainer. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 8949 3. Remove the dress cover by using a flat-blade tool to release the connector locking tabs and pulling off the dress cover. 4. Relieve the tension on the nose piece retainers by inserting J-38125-12A (12094429) into the single retainer slot on the end of the nose piece and gently prying out the locking tab. Repeat the process for both of the nose piece locking tabs on the opposite side of the nose piece. Page 7825 2. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully push the terminal position assurance (TPA) towards the face of the connector on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA is fragile and may break if not done carefully. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. 3. Use the J 38125-215 tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 1466 Release the lower wiredress cover locking tab. Release the upper wiredress cover locking tab. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. Page 1616 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the rear TPA from the connector. 7. IMPORTANT: The front TPA cannot be removed from the connector. Only move it to the release point. Use a small flat-blade tool to move the front TPA to the release position. 8. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 9. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Molex Connectors Page 5721 3. Remove the dress cover by using a flat-blade tool to release the connector locking tabs and pulling off the dress cover. 4. Relieve the tension on the nose piece retainers by inserting J-38125-12A (12094429) into the single retainer slot on the end of the nose piece and gently prying out the locking tab. Repeat the process for both of the nose piece locking tabs on the opposite side of the nose piece. Page 1708 - A control module from another vehicle is installed. - Revised software/calibration files have been released for this vehicle. - IMPORTANT: DO NOT re-program the control module with the SAME software/calibration files that are already present in the control module. This is not an effective repair for any type of concern. Verify that the control module contains the correct software/calibration. If incorrect programming is found, reprogram the control module with the most current software/calibration. Refer to Control Module References for replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Testing for Short to Ground TESTING FOR SHORT TO GROUND NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 4. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit. With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is a short to ground in the circuit. Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2. Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). - When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. - If the DMM does not display voltage 4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is shorted. Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A DIGITAL MULTIMETER NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the powertrain control module (PCM), should only be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200 Digital Multimeter (DMM). The J 39200 instruction manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminage even though voltage is present. The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity. IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading. Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the measurement. Page 244 3. Ensure that the terminal release tang access panel is in the correct location to access the terminals. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) into the terminal release tang access slot located behind the access panel of the connector and press down on the terminal while carefully pulling the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Tyco/AMP Connectors (0.25 Cap) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (025 CAP) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component by pressing down on the connector position assurance (CPA). Page 3262 View of a typical Micro 64 connector. Depress the lock and pull the lever over and past the lock. Page 1612 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully raise the TPA on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA cannot be removed from the connector while there are terminals present in the connector body. View of the TPA when removed from the connector body. 4. Use the J 38125-12A tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the left side of the terminal release cavity as shown in the graphic. Use the tool to move the terminal release to the right with a gentle prying motion. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 1318 It is very important to use the correct test adapter when testing for proper terminal contact of fuses and relays in a bussed electrical center (BEC). Use J-35616-35 to test for proper terminal contact. Failure to use J-35616-35 can result in improper diagnosis of the BEC. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Separate the connector halves. 2. Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body. 3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J-38125 , test that the retention force is significantly different between a good terminal and a suspect terminal. Replace the female terminal in question. FLAT WIRE (DOCK AND LOCK) CONNECTORS There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock) connectors on the harness side or the component side. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Remove the component in question. 2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side of the connector as oil from your skin may be a source of contamination as well. 3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other imperfections that could cause poor terminal contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are uniform and free of damage or deformation. 4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the on the flat wire harness connector in order to test the circuit in question. CONTROL MODULE/COMPONENT VOLTAGE AND GROUNDS Poor voltage or ground connections can cause widely varying symptoms. Test all control module voltage supply circuits. Many vehicles have multiple circuits supplying voltage to a control module. Other components in the system may have separate voltage supply circuits that may also need to be tested. Inspect connections at the module/component connectors, fuses, and any intermediate connections between the voltage source and the module/component. A test lamp or a DMM may indicate that voltage is present, but neither tests the ability of the circuit to carry sufficient current. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Power Distribution Schematics. - Test all control module ground and system ground circuits. The control module may have multiple ground circuits. Other components in the system may have separate grounds that may also need to be tested. Inspect grounds for clean and tight connections at the grounding point. Inspect the connections at the component and in splice packs, where applicable. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Ground Distribution Schematics. TEMPERATURE SENSITIVITY - An intermittent condition may occur when a component/connection reaches normal operating temperature. The condition may occur only when the component/connection is cold, or only when the component/connection is hot. - Freeze Frame, Failure Records, Snapshot, or Vehicle Data Recorder data may help with this type of intermittent condition, where applicable. - If the intermittent is related to heat, review the data for a relationship with the following: High ambient temperatures - Underhood/engine generated heat - Circuit generated heat due to a poor connection, or high electrical load - Higher than normal load conditions, towing, etc. - If the intermittent is related to cold, review the data for the following: Low ambient temperatures-In extremely low temperatures, ice may form in a connection or component. Inspect for water intrusion. - The condition only occurs on a cold start. - The condition goes away when the vehicle warms up. - Information from the customer may help to determine if the trouble follows a pattern that is temperature related. - If temperature is suspected of causing an intermittent fault condition, attempt to duplicate the condition. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required. ELECTROMAGNETIC INTERFERENCE (EMI) AND ELECTRICAL NOISE Some electrical components/circuits are sensitive to electromagnetic interference (EMI) or other types of electrical noise. Inspect for the following conditions: A misrouted harness that is too close to high voltage/high current devices such as secondary ignition components, motors, generator etc-These components may induce electrical noise on a circuit that could interfere with normal circuit operation. - Electrical system interference caused by a malfunctioning relay, or a control module driven solenoid or switch-These conditions can cause a sharp electrical surge. Normally, the condition will occur when the malfunctioning component is operating. - Improper installation of non-factory or aftermarket add on accessories such as lights, 2-way radios, amplifiers, electric motors, remote starters, alarm systems, cell phones, etc-These accessories may lead to interference while in use, but do not fail when the accessories are not in use. - Test for an open diode across the A/C compressor clutch and for other open diodes. Some relays may contain a clamping diode. - The generator may be allowing AC noise into the electrical system. INCORRECT CONTROL MODULE - There are only a few situations where reprogramming a control module is appropriate: A new service control module is installed. Page 4528 MOLEX CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. 2. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. Page 6497 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link). - The wire insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. 5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold them between thumb and forefinger. 7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place. - Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction. - Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip. 8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool closes.Ensure that no strands of wire are cut. 10. Crimp the splice on each end (2). Page 7641 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Ensure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the Terminal Removal Procedure. Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PULL TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL If the terminal is visibly damaged or is suspected of having a faulty connection, the terminal should be replaced. Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors: 1. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) device and/or the secondary lock. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component or separate the connectors for in-line connectors. 3. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device. 4. Insert the proper pick or removal tool into the front of the connector body. 5. IMPORTANT: On connectors with more than one terminal the service loop may not be large enough to remove the terminal and crimp on a new one. If the terminal wire does not have a large enough service loop for removal, cut the wire 5 cm (2 in) behind the connector before removal. Grasp the wire at the back of the connector body and gently push the terminal out the front of the connector body. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. If the wire needed to be cut in order to remove the terminal, gently push a small length of the same size wire through the back of the connector cavity until there is enough wire exposed in order to crimp on a new terminal. If the wire was not cut, cut the existing wire as close to the old terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 4. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. TERMINAL INSTALLATION 1. Align the terminal and pull the wire from the back of the connector in order to seat the terminal. 2. If necessary, cut the new wire to proper length and splice with existing circuit. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. 3. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply dielectric grease to the connector. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PUSH TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 7337 Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. For connectors with a bolt in the dress cover, turn the bolt counterclockwise to remove the connector from the component. 2. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. Page 5935 Oxygen Sensor: Diagnostic Aids Arrows and Symbols Arrows and Symbols This Service Data uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations. Arrows and Symbols 1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow Basic Knowledge Required GENERAL ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures contained in the service manual. You should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current (amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram, as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. Decimal and Metric Equivalents Decimal and Metric Equivalents Page 9031 - JST connectors have JST in small letters on their connectors, similar to that above. The location of the logo will vary with the connector size and style. - Kostel has an "LK" with a circle around it. These connector are usually used as a transmissions connection and are currently use on some Cadillac vehicles. Page 4883 All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system. Page 8754 1. Connect the HO2S electrical connector (3). 2. Install the CPA retainer. Important: A special anti-seize compound is used on the HO2S threads. The compound consists of liquid graphite and glass beads. The graphite tends to burn away, but the glass beads remain, making the sensor easier to remove. New, or service replacement sensors already have the compound applied to the threads. If the sensor is removed from an exhaust component and if for any reason the sensor is to be reinstalled, the threads must have anti-seize compound applied before the reinstallation. 3. If reinstalling the old sensor, coat the threads with anti-seize compound GM P/N 12377953, or equivalent. Notice: Refer to Component Fastener Tightening Notice. Important: If the HO2S sensor is connected to the main wiring harness during installation. Rotate the HO2S sensor several turns counterclockwise before threading the HO2S sensor into the catalytic converter. This action of initially reverse winding of the pigtail wires will prevent a condition where the HO2S sensor pigtail wires become severely twisted or binding once the HO2S sensor is installed into the catalytic converter. 4. Install the HO2S (2). Tighten the sensor to 42 N.m (31 lb ft). 5. Lower the vehicle. Page 3559 Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 3. Install the sensor nut and position the sensor body parallel to the inside wheel surface while torquing. Tighten the sensor nut to 7 N.m (62 lb in). Important: Before reinstalling the tire on the wheel, note the following items to avoid tire pressure sensor damage upon tire mounting. ^ Position the mounting/dismounting head 180 degrees from the valve stem. ^ Position the bead transition area 45 degrees counterclockwise of the valve stem. ^ Using the tire machine, rotate the tire/wheel assembly clockwise when transferring the tire bead to the inside of the wheel rim. ^ Repeat items for outer bead. Install the tire on the wheel. Refer to Tire Mounting and Dismounting. Important: A service replacement tire pressure sensor is shipped in OFF mode. In this mode the sensor's unique identification code cannot be learned into the passenger door modules (PDMs) memory. The sensor must be taken out of OFF mode by spinning the tire/wheel assembly above 32 km/h (20 mph) in order to close the sensors internal roll switch for at least 10 seconds. 4. Install the tire/wheel assembly on the vehicle. Refer to Tire and Wheel Removal and Installation. 5. Lower the vehicle. 6. Learn the tire pressure sensors. Refer to Tire Pressure Sensor Learn. Page 7475 IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals. Front probe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the connector. IMPORTANT: When probing female 0.64 terminals, it is important to use the correct adapter. There have been some revisions to the test adapter for 0.64 terminals. The proper adapter for 0.64 terminals is the J 35616-64B which has a gold terminal and a black wire between the base and tip. Failure to use the proper test adapter may result in damage to the terminal being tested and improper diagnosis. NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Page 3708 Page 7481 Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested: - Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. - Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a component or to other harnesses. - If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A TEST LAMP TOOLS REQUIRED J 35616-200 Test Light - Probe Kit NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminate even though voltage is present. The J 35616-200 is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair of leads. To properly operate this tool use the following procedures. When testing for voltage: 1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested. When testing for ground: 1. Attach one lead to battery positive voltage. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where ground should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is ground at the point being tested. Using Connector Test Adapters USING CONNECTOR TEST ADAPTERS NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Using Fused Jumper Wires USING FUSED JUMPER WIRES TOOLS REQUIRED J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged. The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested. AFL/ECP Connectors AFL/EPC CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 3933 Harmonic Balancer - Crankshaft Pulley: Service and Repair Crankshaft Balancer Replacement Tools Required ^ J 41816 Crankshaft Balancer Remover ^ J 41816-2 Crankshaft End Protector ^ J 42386-A Flywheel Holding Tool ^ J 41665 Crankshaft Balancer and Sprocket Installer ^ J 45059 Angle Meter Removal Procedure 1. Remove the accessory drive belt. Refer to Drive Belt Replacement - Accessory. 2. Remove the air conditioning (A/C) drive belt, if equipped. Refer to Drive Belt Replacement - Air Conditioning. 3. Remove the fan shroud. Refer to Cooling Fan and Shroud Replacement. 4. Remove the starter motor. Refer to Starter Motor Replacement (4.2L Engine) Starter Motor Replacement (5.3L and 6.0L Engines). Important: ^ Ensure that the teeth of J 42386-A mesh with the teeth of the engine flywheel. ^ The crankshaft balancer is balanced as an individual component. It is not necessary to mark the balancer prior to removal. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. Install J 42386-A and bolts. Use one M10-1.5 x 120 mm and one M10-1.5 x 45 mm bolt for proper tool operation. Tighten J 42386-A bolts to 50 N.m (37 lb ft). Page 2815 Washer Fluid Level Switch: Service and Repair WASHER SOLVENT CONTAINER LEVEL SENSOR REPLACEMENT REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Remove the washer solvent container. 2. Using 2 flat-bladed tools, gently pry the level sensor switch (2) from the container (1). 3. Remove the level sensor switch grommet and discard. INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 1. Install a new level sensor switch grommet into the washer solvent container (1). 2. Lubricate the grommet with washer fluid to aid in the installation of the level sensor switch. 3. Ensure the square tab (3) is positioned vertical to the washer container. 4. Push inward in order to seat the level sensor (2) into the grommet. 5. Install the washer solvent container. Page 5176 - JST connectors have JST in small letters on their connectors, similar to that above. The location of the logo will vary with the connector size and style. - Kostel has an "LK" with a circle around it. These connector are usually used as a transmissions connection and are currently use on some Cadillac vehicles. Page 1052 Seat Position Sensor - Recline (w/Memory) Specifications Crankshaft Gear/Sprocket: Specifications Crankshaft Sprocket Install the crankshaft sprocket (207) onto the front of the crankshaft. Align the crankshaft key with the crankshaft sprocket keyway. Use the J 41478 (1) and the J 41665 (2) in order to install the crankshaft sprocket. Install the sprocket onto the crankshaft until fully seated against the crankshaft flange. Rotate the crankshaft sprocket until the alignment mark is in the 12 o'clock position. Page 7346 6. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs located on the opposite side of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover at the connector end and pry up. 7. Remove the dress cover. 8. Cut the tie wrap on the wire bundle. 9. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting a small flat-bladed tool into the small slot in the end of the slider and pushing on the TPA until it comes out of the connector. When the TPA exits the opposite side of the connector, gasp the TPA and pull it completely out of the connector. 10. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 5256 Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Engine Control Module Replacement Service of the engine control module (ECM) should consist of either replacement of the ECM or programming of the electrically erasable programmable read only memory (EEPROM). If the diagnostic procedures call for the ECM to be replaced, the replacement ECM should be checked to ensure that the correct part is being used. If the correct part is being used, remove the faulty ECM and install the new service ECM. The replacement ECM must be programmed. Notice: * Turn the ignition OFF when installing or removing the control module connectors and disconnecting or reconnecting the power to the control module (battery cable, powertrain control module (PCM)/engine control module (ECM)/transaxle control module (TCM) pigtail, control module fuse, jumper cables, etc.) in order to prevent internal control module damage. * Control module damage may result when the metal case contacts battery voltage. DO NOT contact the control module metal case with battery voltage when servicing a control module, using battery booster cables, or when charging the vehicle battery. * In order to prevent any possible electrostatic discharge damage to the control module, do no touch the connector pins or the soldered components on the circuit board. * Remove any debris from around the control module connector surfaces before servicing the control module. Inspect the control module connector gaskets when diagnosing or replacing the control module. Ensure that the gaskets are installed correctly. The gaskets prevent contaminant intrusion into the control module. * The replacement control module must be programmed. Important: It is necessary to record the remaining engine oil life. If the replacement module is not programed with the remaining engine oil life, the engine oil life will default to 100 percent. If the replacement module is not programmed with the remaining engine oil life, the engine oil will need to be changed at 5 000 km (3,000 mi) from the last engine oil change. Removal Procedure 1. Using a scan tool, retrieve the percentage of remaining engine oil. Record the remaining engine oil life. 2. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 3. Disconnect the cooling fan electrical connector for additional clearance while removing the ECM. 4. Squeeze the ECM/transmission control module (TCM) cover upper retainers (1) in. 5. Remove the ECM/TCM cover. Page 600 Power Distribution Relay: Service and Repair Relay Replacement (Within an Electrical Center) RELAY REPLACEMENT (WITHIN AN ELECTRICAL CENTER) TOOLS REQUIRED J 43244 Relay Puller Pliers REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Remove the electrical center cover. 2. Locate the relay. 3. IMPORTANT: - Always note the orientation of the relay. - Ensure that the electrical center is secure, as not to put added stress on the wires or terminals. Using the J 43244 (1) position the tool on opposing corners of the relay (2). 4. NOTE: Use J43244 to pull the relay straight out from the electrical center terminals. The use of pliers or a flat bladed tool could damage the electrical center. Remove the relay (2) from the electrical center. INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 1. Install the relay (2) in the same position as removed. 2. Install the electrical center cover. Page 218 Release the lower wiredress cover locking tab. Release the upper wiredress cover locking tab. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. Page 7503 4. Once the front 2 locks are unlocked, lift the front of the dress cover and pull it forward. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the small slot on the TPA and pushing down until the TPA releases. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to angle or rock the J 38125-21 tool when inserting it into the connector or the tool may break. Insert the J 38125-21 (GM P/N 15381651-2) tool into the round canal between the terminals cavities at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to repair Micro 64 connector terminals. The Micro 64 connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-64 (M jaw) was developed to crimp Micro 64 terminals. The J 38125-64 crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. The J 38125-64 crimping tool is also designed to crimp both the wire and the insulation at the same time. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro 64 terminals. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. 1. Cut the wire as close to the damaged terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. Page 1481 8. Insert the J 38125-213 into the small terminal release hole on the nose piece and gently pull on the back of the wire. 9. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Repairing Connector Terminals REPAIRING CONNECTOR TERMINALS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following: Push to Seat terminals - Pull to Seat terminals Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your terminal repair. The J-38125 contains further information. 1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.For cable seal terminals, remove the seal. 2. Apply the correct cable seal per gage size of the wire, if used.Slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation removal. 3. Remove the insulation. 4. For sealed terminals only, align the seal with the end of the cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal.For sealed terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal. 6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.For sealed terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable. 8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals excepting Micro-Pack 100.64 size. Soldering Micro-Pack 100 World terminals may damage the terminal. Sumitomo Connectors SUMITOMO CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 1711 3. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. View showing depressing of the lever lock release tab. Page 7781 Depress the locks that are located on both sides of the wiredress cover and pull the lever over and past the locks. View of the connector when released from the component. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the front of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool push down on one of the locking tabs and pull the cover up until the dress cover releases. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. Page 5245 Engine Control Module: Connector Views Engine Control Module Connector End Views Engine Control Module (ECM) C1 Page 4502 - Yazaki has a wedge or arrow shape, similar to that shown. Delphi Connectors (Micro .64) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro 64 connectors. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. The lever lock may be located on the top or sides of the wire dress cover. Page 6776 1. Install the air cleaner outlet duct. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Install the air cleaner outlet duct bolt. Tighten the bolt to 10 N.m (89 lb in). 3. Tighten the clamps at the following: * MAF/IAT sensor * Throttle body Tighten the clamps to 7 N.m (62 lb in). 4. Connect the PCV fresh air tube (2) to the air cleaner resonator outlet duct (1). Page 4437 View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. View of the release tool being used for the smaller terminals. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (2-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 2154 6. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by pressing on the tang. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (SENSOR) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) tool into the cavity on the lower right hand face of the connector until the terminal release tang access panel slides over. Page 2077 Page 7226 breakers are used. CIRCUIT BREAKER This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high current is removed. POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) CIRCUIT BREAKER This type greatly increases its resistance when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker will re-close within a second or 2. Circuit Protection - Fuses CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSES The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and examine the element in the fuse for an open (2). If not broken (1), also check for continuity using a DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one of equal current rating. Circuit Protection - Fusible Links CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSIBLE LINKS Page 7974 Page 7780 View of the connector when released from the component. View of another type of Micro 64 connector. Page 3709 Page 6655 Page 7180 Depress the locks that are located on both sides of the wiredress cover and pull the lever over and past the locks. View of the connector when released from the component. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the front of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool push down on one of the locking tabs and pull the cover up until the dress cover releases. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. Page 188 3. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. View showing depressing of the lever lock release tab. Page 7624 11. Insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) into the 2 triangular cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 12. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE 1. Prior to installation the terminal must be aligned so the (1) coding lugs align with the (2) coding grooves on the connector. 2. Once the terminal is aligned, slide the terminal into the cavity until the retainer has engaged in the cavity of the connector. 3. Slide the TPA in the connector body and seat it using a small flat bladed tool. The TPA is seated when it is flush with the contact housing. 4. Secure the wires to the connector body using a tie wrap and replace the dress cover and grommet. Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) BOSCH CONNECTORS (2.8 JPT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Pull out the slider on the connector position assurance (CPA) until it is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 3553 10. Using the tire machine, rotate the tire/wheel assembly clockwise when transferring the tire bead to the inside of the wheel rim. 11. Position the rim so that the valve stem (1) is situated at the 3 o'clock position relative to the head (2). This will protect the sensor when the bottom bead seats. 12. After the bottom bead is on the wheel, reposition the wheel and tire so that the valve stem is situated at the 9 o'clock position relative to the head. This will protect the sensor while mounting the tire bead to the outside of the wheel. Page 8280 REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. The release tab is located on the top of the wiredress cover. View of connector in released position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Page 3723 It is very important to use the correct test adapter when testing for proper terminal contact of fuses and relays in a bussed electrical center (BEC). Use J-35616-35 to test for proper terminal contact. Failure to use J-35616-35 can result in improper diagnosis of the BEC. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Separate the connector halves. 2. Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body. 3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J-38125 , test that the retention force is significantly different between a good terminal and a suspect terminal. Replace the female terminal in question. FLAT WIRE (DOCK AND LOCK) CONNECTORS There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock) connectors on the harness side or the component side. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Remove the component in question. 2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side of the connector as oil from your skin may be a source of contamination as well. 3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other imperfections that could cause poor terminal contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are uniform and free of damage or deformation. 4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the on the flat wire harness connector in order to test the circuit in question. CONTROL MODULE/COMPONENT VOLTAGE AND GROUNDS Poor voltage or ground connections can cause widely varying symptoms. Test all control module voltage supply circuits. Many vehicles have multiple circuits supplying voltage to a control module. Other components in the system may have separate voltage supply circuits that may also need to be tested. Inspect connections at the module/component connectors, fuses, and any intermediate connections between the voltage source and the module/component. A test lamp or a DMM may indicate that voltage is present, but neither tests the ability of the circuit to carry sufficient current. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Power Distribution Schematics. - Test all control module ground and system ground circuits. The control module may have multiple ground circuits. Other components in the system may have separate grounds that may also need to be tested. Inspect grounds for clean and tight connections at the grounding point. Inspect the connections at the component and in splice packs, where applicable. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Ground Distribution Schematics. TEMPERATURE SENSITIVITY - An intermittent condition may occur when a component/connection reaches normal operating temperature. The condition may occur only when the component/connection is cold, or only when the component/connection is hot. - Freeze Frame, Failure Records, Snapshot, or Vehicle Data Recorder data may help with this type of intermittent condition, where applicable. - If the intermittent is related to heat, review the data for a relationship with the following: High ambient temperatures - Underhood/engine generated heat - Circuit generated heat due to a poor connection, or high electrical load - Higher than normal load conditions, towing, etc. - If the intermittent is related to cold, review the data for the following: Low ambient temperatures-In extremely low temperatures, ice may form in a connection or component. Inspect for water intrusion. - The condition only occurs on a cold start. - The condition goes away when the vehicle warms up. - Information from the customer may help to determine if the trouble follows a pattern that is temperature related. - If temperature is suspected of causing an intermittent fault condition, attempt to duplicate the condition. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required. ELECTROMAGNETIC INTERFERENCE (EMI) AND ELECTRICAL NOISE Some electrical components/circuits are sensitive to electromagnetic interference (EMI) or other types of electrical noise. Inspect for the following conditions: A misrouted harness that is too close to high voltage/high current devices such as secondary ignition components, motors, generator etc-These components may induce electrical noise on a circuit that could interfere with normal circuit operation. - Electrical system interference caused by a malfunctioning relay, or a control module driven solenoid or switch-These conditions can cause a sharp electrical surge. Normally, the condition will occur when the malfunctioning component is operating. - Improper installation of non-factory or aftermarket add on accessories such as lights, 2-way radios, amplifiers, electric motors, remote starters, alarm systems, cell phones, etc-These accessories may lead to interference while in use, but do not fail when the accessories are not in use. - Test for an open diode across the A/C compressor clutch and for other open diodes. Some relays may contain a clamping diode. - The generator may be allowing AC noise into the electrical system. INCORRECT CONTROL MODULE - There are only a few situations where reprogramming a control module is appropriate: A new service control module is installed. Page 1266 repairs. 3. Remove the Inflatable Restraint Steering Wheel Module using the procedure found in Service Information. Remove the horn contacts from the steering wheel. Clean the brass contact on the end of the red wires with an abrasive pad. If possible, remove any contamination present on the mating contact on the cancel cam (inside the black tube). Also clean the four copper rivets embedded in the steering wheel frame. Apply GM Dielectric Lubricant to all the contacts to protect against reoccurrence of the corrosion. Refer to the graphic. 4. Reinstall the horn contacts and the Inflatable Restraint Steering Wheel Module and test for proper operation of the horn pad. Test for proper operation of the horn pad through the entire steering wheel rotation. Does the horn pad work properly? ^ Yes - repair is complete. ^ No - proceed with step 5. 5. Is the inoperative condition only present at certain steering wheel positions? ^ Yes - proceed with step 6. ^ No - proceed with step 9. 6. Remove the steering column trim covers. Position the steering wheel on a dead spot. Ground a test light to the steering column frame close to the steering wheel. Probe the surface of the turn signal cancel cam with the test light. Does grounding the cam activate the horn? ^ Yes - this may mean that the contact of the cancel cam that mates to the horn contact wiring harness contact, may not be clean enough or that the cancel cam may need to be replaced. Repair as necessary. Procedure complete. ^ No - proceed with step 7.Turn Signal Cancel Cam: 7. Disconnect the wiring harness that goes to the top of the multi-function switch (connector X1). Using the grounded test light, touch the harness connection for pin G. Does grounding the pin activate the horn? ^ Yes - proceed with step 8. ^ No - try grounding the test light on a known good ground. If this activates the horn, proceed to step 9. If not, investigate a possible condition with the wiring harness or BCM with appropriate SI documents. 8. The condition lies either in the multi-function switch or the interface between the multi-function switch and the cancel cam. In some cases, removing the multi-function switch and clearing the horn contact that mates with the cancel cam (refer to the graphic) of debris and reinstalling the switch will eliminate the condition. In other cases, the cancel cam may be losing contact with the multi-function switch contact. If distortion in the cancel cam is present, it may be necessary to replace the cancel cam. Repair as necessary. Procedure complete. 9. Remove the left side IP insulator (refer to Instrument Panel Insulator Panel Replacement found in SI) so it can be moved aside enough to see the Page 6269 11. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 12. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 13. Center the high temperature SCT1 shrink tube over the DuraSeal splice sleeve. 14. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the high temperature heat shrink tubing. 15. Gradually move the heat from the center to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 16. Replace any reflective tape and clips that may have been remove during the repair. Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation REPAIRING DAMAGED WIRE INSULATION Wire Size Conversion Page 5473 7. Pressing the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool in the release cavity of the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and crimper in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (DOOR MODULE) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Side view of connector. View of top of connector. 1. Locate the assist lever and lock on the top of the connector. Page 8155 The first connector design of the Micro-Pack 100W (1) has a white connector interface that holds the terminals. The second design of the Micro-Pack 100W (2) has a gray interface to hold the terminals. Also, the first design has terminal cavities that are further apart (3 mm centerline) and offset from the other row of terminal cavities in the connector. The second design has terminals cavities that are closer together (2.54 mm centerline) and aligned vertically. One other way to identify the second design is the thin strip of material that runs along the outside of the cavities. IMPORTANT: There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W terminals which are very similar. Ensure that you have the correct terminal before crimping the new terminal to the wire. The first design connector uses the longer terminal (1) that has a raised area in front of the recess in the terminal. The second design connector uses the shorter terminal without the raised area. Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro-Pack 100W connectors. Some Micro-Pack 100W connector disassembly procedures will vary. Use this procedure as a guide. 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 5671 - A control module from another vehicle is installed. - Revised software/calibration files have been released for this vehicle. - IMPORTANT: DO NOT re-program the control module with the SAME software/calibration files that are already present in the control module. This is not an effective repair for any type of concern. Verify that the control module contains the correct software/calibration. If incorrect programming is found, reprogram the control module with the most current software/calibration. Refer to Control Module References for replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Testing for Short to Ground TESTING FOR SHORT TO GROUND NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 4. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit. With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is a short to ground in the circuit. Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2. Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). - When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. - If the DMM does not display voltage 4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is shorted. Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A DIGITAL MULTIMETER NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the powertrain control module (PCM), should only be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200 Digital Multimeter (DMM). The J 39200 instruction manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminage even though voltage is present. The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity. IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading. Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the measurement. Page 3456 Fuse Block - Rear C4 (Pin A17 To B20) Underhood Fuse Block Service and Repair Valve Guide Seal: Service and Repair Valve Stem Oil Seal and Valve Spring Replacement Tools Required ^ J 22794 Spark Plug Port Adapter ^ J 38606 Valve Spring Compressor Removal Procedure 1. Remove the valve rocker arm. Refer to Valve Rocker Arm and Push Rod Replacement. 2. Disconnect the spark plug wire at the spark plug. ^ Twist each plug wire boot 1/2 turn. ^ Pull only on the boot in order to remove the wire from the spark plug. Important: Remove the spark plugs from the cylinder head with the engine at room temperature. 3. Loosen the spark plug 1-2 turns. Cooling System - Inspecting Radiator/Heater Hose Clamps Heater Hose: Technical Service Bulletins Cooling System - Inspecting Radiator/Heater Hose Clamps INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 06-06-02-014B Date: June 13, 2008 Subject: Inspecting Radiator and Heater Hose Clamps and Seals for Leaks During Pre-Delivery Inspection (PDI) Models: 2007 Buick Rainier 2007-2009 Chevrolet TrailBlazer, TrailBlazer SS 2007-2009 GMC Envoy 2007-2009 Saab 9-7X Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2009 model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 06-06-02-014A (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). The purpose of this bulletin is to inform dealers of required inspection of underhood and under vehicle radiator and heater hose clamps and seals for leaks and/or seepage during pre-delivery inspection (PDI). Field feedback indicates that some customers may notice engine coolant leaks shortly after delivery, which may result in an immediate decline of customer satisfaction with their new vehicle purchase. When performing a PDI on a vehicle listed in the models affected above, pay specific attention to the effectiveness of the engine coolant hose seal locations. Reposition/reclamp or replace the clamp to effect a proper system seal prior to customer delivery. Locations to Inspect During PDI Dealership personnel should examine the following locations closely during PDI (4.2L LL8 application shown in graphics below; refer to SI for specific information on 5.3L LH6 and 6.0L LS2):L LH6 and 6.0L LS2): 1. Radiator inlet hose (upper hose) to radiator (1). 2. Radiator inlet hose (upper hose) to engine (2). Page 8309 6. Gently pry the plastic terminal retainer down and carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (16-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, pull the two connector halves apart. Page 5832 The first connector design of the Micro-Pack 100W (1) has a white connector interface that holds the terminals. The second design of the Micro-Pack 100W (2) has a gray interface to hold the terminals. Also, the first design has terminal cavities that are further apart (3 mm centerline) and offset from the other row of terminal cavities in the connector. The second design has terminals cavities that are closer together (2.54 mm centerline) and aligned vertically. One other way to identify the second design is the thin strip of material that runs along the outside of the cavities. IMPORTANT: There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W terminals which are very similar. Ensure that you have the correct terminal before crimping the new terminal to the wire. The first design connector uses the longer terminal (1) that has a raised area in front of the recess in the terminal. The second design connector uses the shorter terminal without the raised area. Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro-Pack 100W connectors. Some Micro-Pack 100W connector disassembly procedures will vary. Use this procedure as a guide. 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 5236 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the DuraSeal splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of a connector. CPAs are used in all SIR System connectors and also in some connectors of other systems. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals of a connection. TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE CLIPS IMPORTANT: When making a splice in an area that may be exposed to moisture use a crimp and seal splice sleeve instead of a Splice Clip. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. Page 2211 Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. For connectors with a bolt in the dress cover, turn the bolt counterclockwise to remove the connector from the component. 2. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. Page 7185 7. Apply pressure and gently rock the cover until one locking leg is unseated. 8. Continue to apply pressure and rock the cover until the second locking leg is unseated. Repeat procedure for the other side of the dress cover and remove the cover. 9. Use J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) to gently lift the terminal retaining tab while gently pulling the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 10. If the terminal is severely bent or damaged, it may be possible on some connectors to push the wire out of the front of the connector instead of Page 5291 Refer to the following table as a guide in selecting the correct test adapter for front probing connectors: Backprobe IMPORTANT: Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures. - Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector. - Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large of a test probe. - After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected, test for proper terminal contact. Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the connector. Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure SCAN TOOL SNAPSHOT PROCEDURE Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used Page 821 to analyze the data during the time a vehicle condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a trigger point that you have determined. Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2 snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a first-in, first-out basis. If a third snapshot is taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost. Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types: Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice - Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200 frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not lost if the Scan Tool is powered down. The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis. The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected values by plotting 3 parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful, especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC. Testing for a Short to Voltage TESTING FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4. Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt, there is a short to voltage in the circuit. Testing for Continuity TESTING FOR CONTINUITY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6. Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit. 7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity. With a Test Lamp IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits. 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6. If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity. Testing for Electrical Intermittents TESTING FOR ELECTRICAL INTERMITTENTS Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment. - Testing for Short to Ground - Testing for Continuity - Testing for a Short to Voltage Page 7486 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (BSK) BOSCH CONNECTORS (BSK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 3. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 4. Insert the J 38125-561 tool into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 5. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is Page 616 Body Control Module: Service and Repair Body Control Module Replacement BODY CONTROL MODULE REPLACEMENT REMOVAL PROCEDURE IMPORTANT: The ignition switch should be in the OFF position when connecting or disconnecting the connectors to the body control module (BCM). - Always disconnect the 40-way body wiring extension FIRST, the 32-way tan connector SECOND and the 24-way gray electrical connector LAST. - Always connect the 24-way gray electrical connector FIRST, the 32-way tan connector SECOND and the 40-way body wiring extension LAST. - The BCM can set DTCs with the ignition switch in the OFF position. The BCM has battery run down protection for the courtesy lamp circuit. The BCM battery run down protection cannot detect shorts on inputs or other circuits which the BCM does not control. Use the scan tool in order to activate the POWER DOWN NOW mode. Use the POWER DOWN NOW mode in order to check for current draws on circuits that are not controlled by the BCM, or controlled by the battery run down protection system. - Do not touch the exposed electrical contacts of the body wiring extension. Do not open the BCM housing. The module does not have any serviceable components. The module may be replaced only as an assembly. 1. CAUTION: Refer to Battery Disconnect Caution. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. If replacing the BCM on a Chevrolet TrailBlazer EXT or GMC Envoy XL, remove the left second row seat. 3. If replacing the BCM on a Chevrolet TrailBlazer or GMC Envoy, position the left hand second seat to a cargo position. 4. Remove the rear electrical center cover. 5. Press down and hold the locking tab (1). 6. Disengage the sliding latch retaining the BCM to the rear electrical center.Slide the latch inboard until fully extended, approximately 40 mm (1.6 in). 7. Disconnect the 40-way body wiring extension (1) from the BCM. Page 2346 2. Locate the nose piece locking tabs that are positioned on the side of the connector nose piece. The connector nose piece acts as a terminal positive assurance (TPA) and may be referred to as such. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to push in one of the locking tabs while gently pulling on the same side of the nose piece. 4. Repeat the procedure for the other locking tab and remove the nose piece. 5. Remove the wire dress cover. The following is a general procedure for wire dress cover removal. Use this procedure as a guide, some dress cover removal procedures may vary. 6. Use fingers to squeeze the 2 locking legs of the cover. Page 5318 4. Once the front 2 locks are unlocked, lift the front of the dress cover and pull it forward. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the small slot on the TPA and pushing down until the TPA releases. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to angle or rock the J 38125-21 tool when inserting it into the connector or the tool may break. Insert the J 38125-21 (GM P/N 15381651-2) tool into the round canal between the terminals cavities at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to repair Micro 64 connector terminals. The Micro 64 connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-64 (M jaw) was developed to crimp Micro 64 terminals. The J 38125-64 crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. The J 38125-64 crimping tool is also designed to crimp both the wire and the insulation at the same time. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro 64 terminals. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. 1. Cut the wire as close to the damaged terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. Page 7237 11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the solder equipment. 12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. 13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to cover the first piece of tape. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE SLEEVES TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit IMPORTANT: Use only dura seal splice sleeves. Other splice sleeves may not protect the splice from moisture or provide a good electrical connection. Use duraseal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. Use duraseal splice sleeves where there is special requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire using duraseal splice sleeves. Page 3376 - JST connectors have JST in small letters on their connectors, similar to that above. The location of the logo will vary with the connector size and style. - Kostel has an "LK" with a circle around it. These connector are usually used as a transmissions connection and are currently use on some Cadillac vehicles. Page 2108 11. Insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) into the 2 triangular cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 12. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE 1. Prior to installation the terminal must be aligned so the (1) coding lugs align with the (2) coding grooves on the connector. 2. Once the terminal is aligned, slide the terminal into the cavity until the retainer has engaged in the cavity of the connector. 3. Slide the TPA in the connector body and seat it using a small flat bladed tool. The TPA is seated when it is flush with the contact housing. 4. Secure the wires to the connector body using a tie wrap and replace the dress cover and grommet. Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) BOSCH CONNECTORS (2.8 JPT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Pull out the slider on the connector position assurance (CPA) until it is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 1705 to analyze the data during the time a vehicle condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a trigger point that you have determined. Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2 snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a first-in, first-out basis. If a third snapshot is taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost. Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types: Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice - Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200 frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not lost if the Scan Tool is powered down. The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis. The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected values by plotting 3 parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful, especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC. Testing for a Short to Voltage TESTING FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4. Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt, there is a short to voltage in the circuit. Testing for Continuity TESTING FOR CONTINUITY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6. Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit. 7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity. With a Test Lamp IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits. 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6. If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity. Testing for Electrical Intermittents TESTING FOR ELECTRICAL INTERMITTENTS Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment. - Testing for Short to Ground - Testing for Continuity - Testing for a Short to Voltage Page 6061 Throttle Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids Arrows and Symbols Arrows and Symbols This Service Data uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations. Arrows and Symbols 1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow Basic Knowledge Required GENERAL ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures contained in the service manual. You should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current (amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram, as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. Decimal and Metric Equivalents Decimal and Metric Equivalents Page 1377 6. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by pressing on the tang. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (SENSOR) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) tool into the cavity on the lower right hand face of the connector until the terminal release tang access panel slides over. Page 237 7. The illustration above identifies the entry canal where the terminal release tool will be inserted, and the terminal cavity. - Terminal (1) - Entry Canal (2) 8. Insert the J-38125-553 (15315247) tool into the entry canal and pry up on the terminal retainer. The terminal retainer is a small plastic piece on the top of the terminal. The terminal retainer must be held up while the terminal is pulled out of the connector. Page 4775 Page 2286 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the DuraSeal splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of a connector. CPAs are used in all SIR System connectors and also in some connectors of other systems. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals of a connection. TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE CLIPS IMPORTANT: When making a splice in an area that may be exposed to moisture use a crimp and seal splice sleeve instead of a Splice Clip. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. Page 1494 5. While pushing the terminal forward, insert the J 38125-24 in the release cavity above the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (43-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Diagram Information and Instructions Throttle Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions Electrical Symbols Wheels - Changing Procedures/Precautions Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels - Changing Procedures/Precautions INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 06-03-10-010A Date: June 09, 2010 Subject: Information on Proper Wheel Changing Procedures and Cautions Models: 2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks 2010 and Prior HUMMER Models 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X 2005-2009 Saturn Vehicles Attention: Complete wheel changing instructions for each vehicle line can be found under Tire and Wheel Removal and Installation in Service Information (SI). This bulletin is intended to quickly review and reinforce simple but vital procedures to reduce the possibility of achieving low torque during wheel installation. Always refer to SI for wheel lug nut torque specifications and complete jacking instructions for safe wheel changing. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to include the 2011 model year and update the available special tool list. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 06-03-10-010 (Section 03 Suspension). Frequency of Wheel Changes - Marketplace Driven Just a few years ago, the increasing longevity of tires along with greater resistance to punctures had greatly reduced the number of times wheels were removed to basically required tire rotation intervals. Today with the booming business in accessory wheels/special application tires (such as winter tires), consumers are having tire/wheel assemblies removed - replaced - or installed more than ever. With this increased activity, it opens up more of a chance for error on the part of the technician. This bulletin will review a few of the common concerns and mistakes to make yourself aware of. Proper Servicing Starts With the Right Tools The following tools have been made available to assist in proper wheel and tire removal and installation. - J 41013 Rotor Resurfacing Kit (or equivalent) - J 42450-A Wheel Hub Resurfacing Kit (or equivalent) Corroded Surfaces One area of concern is corrosion on the mating surfaces of the wheel to the hub on the vehicle. Excessive corrosion, dirt, rust or debris built up on these surfaces can mimic a properly tightened wheel in the service stall. Once the vehicle is driven, the debris may loosen, grind up or be washed away from water splash. This action may result in clearance at the mating surface of the wheel and an under-torqued condition. Caution Before installing a wheel, remove any buildup on the wheel mounting surface and brake drum or brake disc mounting surface. Installing wheels with poor metal-to-metal contact at the mounting surfaces can cause wheel nuts to loosen. This may cause a wheel to come off when the vehicle is moving, possibly resulting in a loss of control or personal injury. Whenever you remove the tire/wheel assemblies, you must inspect the mating surfaces. If corrosion is found, you should remove the debris with a die grinder equipped with a fine sanding pad, wire brush or cleaning disc. Just remove enough material to assure a clean, smooth mating surface. The J 41013 (or equivalent) can be used to clean the following surfaces: - The hub mounting surface - The brake rotor mounting surface - The wheel mounting surface Use the J 42450-A (or equivalent) to clean around the base of the studs and the hub. Lubricants, Grease and Fluids Page 4511 pulling it through. This will prevent damage to the internal seals of the connector. Once the terminal is pushed out of the connector, cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible and pull the wire through the connector. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE The Micro-Pack 100W connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool was developed to crimp Micro-Pack 100W terminals. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 2. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert the terminal into the crimp tool until the core wings are flush with the anvil on the crimp tool. Be sure that the wings are pointed toward the crimp tool former and release the spring locator. The locator will hold the terminal in place. Inspect the alignment of the terminal wings with the crimp tool former. If the terminal wings are wider than the crimp tool former, remove the terminal and bend the terminal wings in slightly. 5. Place stripped wire into terminal. 6. Crimp the new terminal to the wire. If a jam occurs, press the emergency release to open applicator. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire perform the following procedure in order to replace Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. Page 8251 difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Bosch Connectors (ECM) BOSCH CONNECTORS (ECM) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the assist lever on the top of the connector. Move the assist lever to the forward position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 4608 - Kostel - Molex - Sumitomo - Tyco/AMP - Yazaki Identifying the manufacturer of a connector is often difficult. When trying to determine the manufacturer of a connector, look for specific identifying marks that are unique to that connector supplier. Most of these identify marks are hard to find or see. Check the connector carefully and refer to the information below for pictures and descriptions of connector identification markings. - Most of AFLs connectors have EPC on their connector body. Some of the smaller connectors will not have any markings on them. - In some cases Bosch will actually be printed on the connector. If Bosch does not appear on the connector, look for the Bosch logo. The Bosch logo is a circle with a blunted arrow inside. This logo can appear anywhere on the connector and is often very small. Page 735 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry one side of the nose piece up to the pre-stage position. When the nose piece is in the pre-staged position, the nose piece will be raised above the connector body the length of the step in the nose piece. 7. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry the other side of the piece to the pre-stage position. If the nose piece is higher than the first step in the nose piece, gently push down on the nose piece until it meets with resistance from the connector body, you should feel the nose piece click into position. Page 3192 Refrigerant: Service and Repair Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging Tools Required * J43600 ACR 2000 Air Conditioning Service Center * J45037 A/C Oil Injector Caution: Avoid breathing the A/C Refrigerant 134a (R-134a) and the lubricant vapor or the mist. Exposure may irritate the eyes, nose, and throat. Work in a well ventilated area. In order to remove R-134a from the A/C system, use service equipment that is certified to meet the requirements of SAE J2210 (R-134a recycling equipment). If an accidental system discharge occurs, ventilate the work area before continuing service. Additional health and safety information may be obtained from the refrigerant and lubricant manufacturers. Caution: For personal protection, goggles and gloves should be worn and a clean cloth wrapped around fittings, valves, and connections when doing work that includes opening the refrigerant system. If R-134a comes in contact with any part of the body severe frostbite and personal injury can result. The exposed area should be flushed immediately with cold water and prompt medical help should be obtained. Notice: R-134a is the only approved refrigerant for use in this vehicle. The use of any other refrigerant may result in poor system performance or component failure. Notice: To avoid system damage use only R-134a dedicated tools when servicing the A/C system. Notice: Use only Polyalkylene Glycol Synthetic Refrigerant Oil (PAG) for internal circulation through the R-134a A/C system and only 525 viscosity mineral oil on fitting threads and O-rings. If lubricants other than those specified are used, compressor failure and/or fitting seizure may result. Notice: R-12 refrigerant and R-134a refrigerant must never be mixed, even in the smallest of amounts, as they are incompatible with each other. If the refrigerants are mixed, compressor failure is likely to occur. Refer to the manufacturer instructions included with the service equipment before servicing. The J43600 is a complete air conditioning service center for R-134a. The ACR 2000 recovers, recycles, evacuates and recharges A/C refrigerant quickly, accurately and automatically. The unit has a display screen that contains the function controls and displays prompts that will lead the technician through the recover, recycle, evacuate and recharge operations. R-134a is recovered into and charged out of an internal storage vessel. The ACR 2000 automatically replenishes this vessel from an external source tank in order to maintain a constant 5.45-6.82 kg (12-15 lbs) of A/C refrigerant. The ACR 2000 has a built in A/C refrigerant identifier that will test for contamination, prior to recovery and will notify the technician if there are foreign gases present in the A/C system. If foreign gases are present, the ACR 2000 will not recover the refrigerant from the A/C system. The ACR 2000 also features automatic air purge, single pass recycling and an automatic oil drain. Refer to the J43600 ACR 2000 manual for operation and setup instruction. Always recharge the A/C System with the proper amount of R-134a. Refer to Refrigerant System Capacities for the correct amount. A/C Refrigerant System Oil Charge Replenishing If oil was removed from the A/C system during the recovery process or due to component replacement, the oil must be replenished. Oil can be injected into a charged system using J45037. For the proper quantities of oil to add to the A/C refrigerant system, refer to Refrigerant System Capacities. Page 8364 Page 6256 5. While pushing the terminal forward, insert the J 38125-24 in the release cavity above the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (43-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Page 1348 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Ensure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the Terminal Removal Procedure. Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PULL TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL If the terminal is visibly damaged or is suspected of having a faulty connection, the terminal should be replaced. Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors: 1. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) device and/or the secondary lock. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component or separate the connectors for in-line connectors. 3. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device. 4. Insert the proper pick or removal tool into the front of the connector body. 5. IMPORTANT: On connectors with more than one terminal the service loop may not be large enough to remove the terminal and crimp on a new one. If the terminal wire does not have a large enough service loop for removal, cut the wire 5 cm (2 in) behind the connector before removal. Grasp the wire at the back of the connector body and gently push the terminal out the front of the connector body. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. If the wire needed to be cut in order to remove the terminal, gently push a small length of the same size wire through the back of the connector cavity until there is enough wire exposed in order to crimp on a new terminal. If the wire was not cut, cut the existing wire as close to the old terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 4. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. TERMINAL INSTALLATION 1. Align the terminal and pull the wire from the back of the connector in order to seat the terminal. 2. If necessary, cut the new wire to proper length and splice with existing circuit. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. 3. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply dielectric grease to the connector. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PUSH TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 7878 6. Engage the sliding latch fastening the BCM to the rear electrical center. Slide the latch outboard until the locking tab (1) is fully seated. 7. Install the rear electrical center cover. 8. If replacing the BCM on a Chevrolet TrailBlazer or GMC Envoy, position the left hand second seat to a passenger position. 9. If replacing the BCM on a Chevrolet TrailBlazer EXT or GMC Envoy XL, install the left second row seat. 10. Connect the negative battery cable. 11. If installing a replacement BCM, program the BCM. Refer to Control Module References. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Page 3397 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. JST Connectors JST CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, remove the connector from the component. Page 6665 - A control module from another vehicle is installed. - Revised software/calibration files have been released for this vehicle. - IMPORTANT: DO NOT re-program the control module with the SAME software/calibration files that are already present in the control module. This is not an effective repair for any type of concern. Verify that the control module contains the correct software/calibration. If incorrect programming is found, reprogram the control module with the most current software/calibration. Refer to Control Module References for replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Testing for Short to Ground TESTING FOR SHORT TO GROUND NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 4. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit. With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is a short to ground in the circuit. Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2. Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). - When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. - If the DMM does not display voltage 4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is shorted. Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A DIGITAL MULTIMETER NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the powertrain control module (PCM), should only be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200 Digital Multimeter (DMM). The J 39200 instruction manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminage even though voltage is present. The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity. IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading. Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the measurement. Page 3946 Important: ^ Do not reuse the crankshaft oil seal or rear cover gasket. ^ Do not apply any type of sealant to the rear cover gasket unless specified. ^ The special tool in this procedure is used to properly center the crankshaft rear oil seal. ^ Install the crankshaft rear oil seal after the rear cover has been installed and aligned. Install the rear cover without the crankshaft oil seal. - All gasket surfaces should be free of oil or other foreign material during assembly. - Center the crankshaft rear oil seal in relation to the crankshaft. - An improperly aligned rear cover may cause premature rear oil seal wear and/or engine assembly oil leaks. Apply a 5 mm (0.2 in) bead of sealant 20 mm (0.8 in) long to the oil pan to engine block junction. Refer to Sealers, Adhesives, and Lubricants for the correct part number. 1. Install the rear cover gasket and cover. 2. Install the rear cover bolts until snug. Do NOT over tighten. Page 1918 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Start in the middle and gradually move the heat barrel to the open ends of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Heated Oxygen Sensor Wiring Repairs HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being obstructed. If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. - Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks, etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire. - Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance. - To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector. Page 4610 - JST connectors have JST in small letters on their connectors, similar to that above. The location of the logo will vary with the connector size and style. - Kostel has an "LK" with a circle around it. These connector are usually used as a transmissions connection and are currently use on some Cadillac vehicles. Page 6799 Tighten Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb in). Note The repair area MUST BE properly refinished to maintain a secure, stable and corrosion-free electrical ground. 12. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and Repair in SI. 13. Verify proper system operation. M8 Weld Nut Caution Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground repair. 1. If the M8 weld nut electrical ground location is accessible from both sides of the panel, a M8 conductive bolt and a M8 conductive nut may be used to secure the electrical ground wire terminal. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 2. Select a location adjacent the M8 weld nut having 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance behind the panel surface and 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance surrounding the new electrical ground site. 3. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the surface surrounding the ground location and allow to dry. Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled. 4. Drill a 10 mm (0.40 in) diameter hole through the panel. 5. Remove paint and primer from the area surrounding the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole until bare metal is visible. 6. Select a M8 conductive bolt. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 7. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M8 conductive bolt. Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase. 8. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground wire terminal. 9. Install the electrical ground wire terminal and the M8 conductive bolt to the ground location. 10. Select a M8 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 11. Install the M8 conductive nut to the bolt and: Tighten Tighten to 22 Nm (16 lb ft). Note The repair area MUST BE properly refinished to maintain a secure, stable and corrosion-free electrical ground. 12. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and Repair in SI. 13. Verify proper system operation. M8 Weld Nut Alternative Repair Caution Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground repair. 1. If the M8 weld nut electrical ground location is not accessible from both sides of the panel, a M6 conductive rivet stud and a M6 conductive nut may be used to secure the electrical ground wire terminal. 2. Select a location adjacent the damaged M8 weld nut having 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance behind the panel surface and 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance surrounding the M6 conductive rivet stud flange. 3. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the repair site and allow to dry. Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled. 4. Drill a 10 mm (0.40 in) diameter hole through the panel. Page 1637 6. Gently pry the plastic terminal retainer down and carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (16-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, pull the two connector halves apart. Page 7085 2. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully push the terminal position assurance (TPA) towards the face of the connector on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA is fragile and may break if not done carefully. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. 3. Use the J 38125-215 tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 3440 6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias. Reference the appropriate service manual wiring schematic to obtain the correct diode installation position. 7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for the soldering equipment. 8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed. 9. IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode attachment points with tape. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape. Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable SPLICING TWISTED OR SHIELDED CABLE Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable. 1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splice is made. 3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire. Staggering the splices by 65 mm (2.5 in) is recommended. 4. IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical contact with the drain wire. Re-assemble the cable. Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape. - Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1). - Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire. - Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape. Page 6417 If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200 DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J 39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected. IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J 39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and maximum (MAX) values measured. 1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of a suspected circuit to the other. 2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J 39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep). IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value in order to record the full change. 5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling the connections or the wiring, test driving, or performing other operations. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions. 6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9. Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist. Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections TESTING FOR INTERMITTENT CONDITIONS AND POOR CONNECTIONS TOOLS REQUIRED - J 35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit - J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit When the condition is not currently present, but is indicated in DTC history, the cause may be intermittent. An intermittent may also be the cause when there is a customer complaint, but the symptom cannot be duplicated. Refer to the Symptom Table of the system that is suspect of causing the condition before trying to locate an intermittent condition. Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the following items: Wiring broken inside the insulation - Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector - Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself, and corrosion in the wire to terminal contact area, etc. - Pierced or damaged insulation can allow moisture to enter the wiring causing corrosion. The conductor can corrode inside the insulation, with little visible evidence. Look for swollen and stiff sections of wire in the suspect circuits. - Wiring which has been pinched, cut, or its insulation rubbed through may cause an intermittent open or short as the bare area touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle. - Wiring that comes in contact with hot or exhaust components - Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required, in order to verify the customer concern. - Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. - Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis and Vehicle Data Recorder operation. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any inline connectors before replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation. Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination, usually in the underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit. Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper adapter. Always use the J 35616 when probing connectors. Other causes of terminal deformation are improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT IN BUSSED ELECTRICAL CENTERS (BEC) Page 2392 The engine harness may be repaired using the J-38125. High Temperature Wiring Repairs HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperatures, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time may use materials i.e. wires, connectors, and shielding that has a higher heat rating than typical wiring. When making a repair in a high temperature area observe the following: Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature to replace any damaged wire. - Replace any heat shielding that is removed. - Cover any DuraSeal splice sleeves with SCT1 shrink tubing (available in the J-38125 Terminal Repair kit). - After making a wiring repair, ensure that the location of the wiring is not moved closer to the heat source. IDENTIFYING HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperature, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time need special considerations when making wiring repairs. Areas that may be exposed to higher temperatures can be identified by heat resistant materials that are being used in those areas. These materials may include heat reflective tape, moon tape, and high temperature shrink tubing. Also conduit and other protective coverings may be used. Because conduit or similar coverings are used throughout the vehicle regardless of the temperature, it may be necessary for the technician to determine if an area is exposed to excessive heat before making a wiring repair. Obvious areas of consideration would be any area located near the exhaust manifolds, catalytic converter, and exhaust pipes. The J-38125 contains much of the material you will need to perform repairs on areas exposed to high heat. The kit contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves to crimp and seal connections - High temperature SCT1 shrink tubing to protect the splice sleeves - A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct crimp tool to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools to remove the terminals from the connectors The J-38125 does not contain wire that is suitable to high temperature exposure. Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature of the same or larger gage size as the original wire when repair damage wire. Also replace any reflective tape that you remove during the repair. HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature rating of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125 and then encapsulate the splice sleeve using the high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the order listed. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip keeping all of the wire strands intact. Page 6467 8. Insert the J 38125-213 into the small terminal release hole on the nose piece and gently pull on the back of the wire. 9. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Repairing Connector Terminals REPAIRING CONNECTOR TERMINALS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following: Push to Seat terminals - Pull to Seat terminals Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your terminal repair. The J-38125 contains further information. 1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.For cable seal terminals, remove the seal. 2. Apply the correct cable seal per gage size of the wire, if used.Slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation removal. 3. Remove the insulation. 4. For sealed terminals only, align the seal with the end of the cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal.For sealed terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal. 6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.For sealed terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable. 8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals excepting Micro-Pack 100.64 size. Soldering Micro-Pack 100 World terminals may damage the terminal. Sumitomo Connectors SUMITOMO CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 3427 breakers are used. CIRCUIT BREAKER This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high current is removed. POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) CIRCUIT BREAKER This type greatly increases its resistance when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker will re-close within a second or 2. Circuit Protection - Fuses CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSES The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and examine the element in the fuse for an open (2). If not broken (1), also check for continuity using a DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one of equal current rating. Circuit Protection - Fusible Links CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSIBLE LINKS Page 3028 3. Radiator outlet hose (lower hose) to engine (3). (Shown as viewed from below.) 4. Radiator outlet hose (lower hose) to radiator (4). (Shown as viewed from below.) 5. Heater inlet hose to engine (5). Page 6453 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the TPA. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the nose piece. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. Page 4950 7. Pressing the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool in the release cavity of the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and crimper in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (DOOR MODULE) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Side view of connector. View of top of connector. 1. Locate the assist lever and lock on the top of the connector. Page 467 vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide variety of actions, including: - Wiggling the harness - Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting - Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector - Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation - Relocating a harness or wires All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. Another option is, with the component commanded ON and OFF by the scan tool, move related connectors and wiring and observe the component operation. With the engine running, move related connectors and wiring while monitoring engine operation. If harness or connector movement affects the data displayed, component/system operation, or engine operation, inspect and repair the harness/connections as necessary. You may need to load the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these cases you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide good results as well. There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions, along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the circuit to these kinds of conditions. SALT WATER SPRAY Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture. Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5 percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously. HIGH TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070. Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault condition. The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis. This option does not allow for the same control, however. LOW TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect. If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to -18°C (0°F) from one end and +71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized cooling needs. Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or components in an effort to duplicate the concern. DUPLICATING FAILURE CONDITIONS - If none of the previous tests are successful, attempt to duplicate and/or capture the failure conditions. Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, where applicable, contains the conditions that were present when the DTC set. 1. Review and record Freeze Frame/Failure Records data. 2. Clear the DTCs using the scan tool. 3. Turn the key to OFF and wait 15 seconds. 4. Operate the vehicle under the same conditions that were noted in Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, as closely as possible. The vehicle must also be operating within the Conditions for Running the DTC. Refer to Conditions for Running the DTC in the supporting text if a DTC is being diagnosed. 5. Monitor DTC Status for the DTC being tested. The scan tool will indicate Ran, when the enabling conditions have been satisfied long enough for the DTC to run. The scan tool will also indicate whether the DTC passed or failed. - An alternate method is to drive the vehicle with the DMM connected to a suspected circuit. An abnormal reading on the DMM when the concern occurs, may help you locate the concern. Measuring Frequency Page 6918 REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. The release tab is located on the top of the wiredress cover. View of connector in released position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Page 1803 Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Diagrams Engine Controls Connector End Views Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor Page 6360 7. The illustration above identifies the entry canal where the terminal release tool will be inserted, and the terminal cavity. - Terminal (1) - Entry Canal (2) 8. Insert the J-38125-553 (15315247) tool into the entry canal and pry up on the terminal retainer. The terminal retainer is a small plastic piece on the top of the terminal. The terminal retainer must be held up while the terminal is pulled out of the connector. Page 1077 Sunroof Switch Page 8685 7. Apply pressure and gently rock the cover until one locking leg is unseated. 8. Continue to apply pressure and rock the cover until the second locking leg is unseated. Repeat procedure for the other side of the dress cover and remove the cover. 9. Use J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) to gently lift the terminal retaining tab while gently pulling the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 10. If the terminal is severely bent or damaged, it may be possible on some connectors to push the wire out of the front of the connector instead of Page 2191 Page 8398 - Kostel - Molex - Sumitomo - Tyco/AMP - Yazaki Identifying the manufacturer of a connector is often difficult. When trying to determine the manufacturer of a connector, look for specific identifying marks that are unique to that connector supplier. Most of these identify marks are hard to find or see. Check the connector carefully and refer to the information below for pictures and descriptions of connector identification markings. - Most of AFLs connectors have EPC on their connector body. Some of the smaller connectors will not have any markings on them. - In some cases Bosch will actually be printed on the connector. If Bosch does not appear on the connector, look for the Bosch logo. The Bosch logo is a circle with a blunted arrow inside. This logo can appear anywhere on the connector and is often very small. Page 4550 View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. 4. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers CIRCUIT PROTECTION - CIRCUIT BREAKERS A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types of circuit Page 2233 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert terminal into the appropriate terminal holder until it hits bottom and stops. The correct terminal holder is determined by the wire size. Also ensure that the terminals wings are pointing towards the former on the tool and the release locator. 5. Insert the stripped cable into the terminal. Insulation should be visible on both sides of the terminal insulation wings. 6. Compress the handles until the ratchet automatically releases. 7. Place the terminal into the appropriate cavity and assemble the connector. Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO-PACK 100W) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W connectors. These connectors are very similar but use different terminals and have some minor physical differences also. Page 8082 Engine Control Module (ECM) C2 (Pin 11 To 54) Page 6114 View of typical connector. View of connector in released position. 1. Locate the assist lever at the back of the connector. Move the assist lever to the rear position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the dress cover. Page 5188 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Ensure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the Terminal Removal Procedure. Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PULL TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL If the terminal is visibly damaged or is suspected of having a faulty connection, the terminal should be replaced. Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors: 1. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) device and/or the secondary lock. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component or separate the connectors for in-line connectors. 3. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device. 4. Insert the proper pick or removal tool into the front of the connector body. 5. IMPORTANT: On connectors with more than one terminal the service loop may not be large enough to remove the terminal and crimp on a new one. If the terminal wire does not have a large enough service loop for removal, cut the wire 5 cm (2 in) behind the connector before removal. Grasp the wire at the back of the connector body and gently push the terminal out the front of the connector body. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. If the wire needed to be cut in order to remove the terminal, gently push a small length of the same size wire through the back of the connector cavity until there is enough wire exposed in order to crimp on a new terminal. If the wire was not cut, cut the existing wire as close to the old terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 4. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. TERMINAL INSTALLATION 1. Align the terminal and pull the wire from the back of the connector in order to seat the terminal. 2. If necessary, cut the new wire to proper length and splice with existing circuit. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. 3. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply dielectric grease to the connector. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PUSH TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 6329 View of the connector when released from the component. View of another type of Micro 64 connector. Locations Fuse Block: Locations Fuse Block - Underhood Fuse Block - Rear Page 4457 US English/Metric Conversion US English/Metric Conversion Page 3979 3. Loosen the spark plug 1-2 turns. 4. Brush or air blast away any dirt or debris from around the spark plug. 5. Remove the spark plug. 6. Install J 22794 into the spark plug hole. 7. Attach an air hose to J 22794. 8. Apply compressed air to J 22794 in order to hold the valves in place. 9. Use J 38606 in order to compress the valve spring. 10. Remove the valve stem keys (2). 11. Carefully release the valve spring tension. 12. Remove J 38606. 13. Remove the valve spring cap (3). 14. Remove the valve spring (4). 15. Remove the valve stem oil seal/shim assembly (1, 5). Installation Procedure Specifications Spark Plug: Specifications Spark Plug Gap ................................................................................................................................... ...................................................... 1.02 mm (0.040in) Spark Plug Torque ......................................... ............................................................................................................................................. 15 N.m (11 lb ft) Page 5898 Knock Sensor: Service and Repair Knock Sensor Replacement (Right Side) Knock Sensor Replacement (Right Side) Removal Procedure 1. Disconnect the electrical connector (3) from the knock sensor (2). 2. Remove the knock sensor bolt (1). 3. Remove the knock sensor (2) from the engine block. Installation Procedure 1. Position the knock sensor (2) on the engine block. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Install the knock sensor bolt (1). Tighten the bolt (1) to 20 N.m (15 lb ft). 3. Connect the electrical connector (3) to the knock sensor (2). Page 7433 Notice: Refer to Handling Electrostatic Discharge Sensitive Parts Notice. Important: * It is not necessary to disconnect the ECM electrical connectors in order to remove the ECM from the ECM/TCM bracket. Only disconnect the electrical connectors if servicing of component requires disconnecting of the electrical connectors. * Remove any debris from around the ECM connector surfaces before servicing the ECM. Inspect the ECM module connector gaskets when diagnosing or replacing the ECM. Ensure that the gaskets are installed correctly. The gaskets prevent contaminant intrusion into the ECM. Disconnect the engine wiring harness electrical connectors from the ECM. 6. Release the ECM/TCM bracket upper retainers (1). 7. Tilt the ECM away from the bracket and remove the ECM. Page 8266 Depress the locks that are located on both sides of the wiredress cover and pull the lever over and past the locks. View of the connector when released from the component. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the front of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool push down on one of the locking tabs and pull the cover up until the dress cover releases. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. Page 3216 Fuse Block - Underhood (5.3L/6.0L), Label Usage Page 2809 Power Window Switch: Service and Repair Rear Side Door Window Switch Replacement REAR SIDE DOOR WINDOW SWITCH REPLACEMENT REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Using a flat-bladed tool, remove the window switch bezel from the door trim panel. 2. Disconnect the electrical connector from the window switch. 3. Release the retaining clips that attach the power window switch to the bezel. 4. Remove the switch from the bezel. INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 1. Install the switch to the bezel. Ensure that the retainers are fully seated. 2. Connect the electrical connector to the window switch. 3. Install the window switch bezel to the door trim panel. 4. Ensure that the window switch bezel retaining clips are fully seated. Page 4574 Page 2393 Open the harness by removing any tape. 2. Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. 3. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 4. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent american wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 5. Slide a section of high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing down the length of wire to be spliced. Ensure that the shrink tubing will not interfere with the splice procedure. 6. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 7. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. 8. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 9. Insert the wire into the DuraSeal splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 10. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Page 7973 Page 1430 to analyze the data during the time a vehicle condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a trigger point that you have determined. Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2 snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a first-in, first-out basis. If a third snapshot is taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost. Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types: Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice - Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200 frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not lost if the Scan Tool is powered down. The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis. The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected values by plotting 3 parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful, especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC. Testing for a Short to Voltage TESTING FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4. Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt, there is a short to voltage in the circuit. Testing for Continuity TESTING FOR CONTINUITY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6. Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit. 7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity. With a Test Lamp IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits. 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6. If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity. Testing for Electrical Intermittents TESTING FOR ELECTRICAL INTERMITTENTS Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment. - Testing for Short to Ground - Testing for Continuity - Testing for a Short to Voltage Page 1565 vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide variety of actions, including: - Wiggling the harness - Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting - Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector - Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation - Relocating a harness or wires All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. Another option is, with the component commanded ON and OFF by the scan tool, move related connectors and wiring and observe the component operation. With the engine running, move related connectors and wiring while monitoring engine operation. If harness or connector movement affects the data displayed, component/system operation, or engine operation, inspect and repair the harness/connections as necessary. You may need to load the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these cases you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide good results as well. There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions, along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the circuit to these kinds of conditions. SALT WATER SPRAY Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture. Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5 percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously. HIGH TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070. Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault condition. The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis. This option does not allow for the same control, however. LOW TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect. If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to -18°C (0°F) from one end and +71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized cooling needs. Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or components in an effort to duplicate the concern. DUPLICATING FAILURE CONDITIONS - If none of the previous tests are successful, attempt to duplicate and/or capture the failure conditions. Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, where applicable, contains the conditions that were present when the DTC set. 1. Review and record Freeze Frame/Failure Records data. 2. Clear the DTCs using the scan tool. 3. Turn the key to OFF and wait 15 seconds. 4. Operate the vehicle under the same conditions that were noted in Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, as closely as possible. The vehicle must also be operating within the Conditions for Running the DTC. Refer to Conditions for Running the DTC in the supporting text if a DTC is being diagnosed. 5. Monitor DTC Status for the DTC being tested. The scan tool will indicate Ran, when the enabling conditions have been satisfied long enough for the DTC to run. The scan tool will also indicate whether the DTC passed or failed. - An alternate method is to drive the vehicle with the DMM connected to a suspected circuit. An abnormal reading on the DMM when the concern occurs, may help you locate the concern. Measuring Frequency Page 9054 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully raise the TPA on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA cannot be removed from the connector while there are terminals present in the connector body. View of the TPA when removed from the connector body. 4. Use the J 38125-12A tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the left side of the terminal release cavity as shown in the graphic. Use the tool to move the terminal release to the right with a gentle prying motion. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 2009 REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. The release tab is located on the top of the wiredress cover. View of connector in released position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Page 8412 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Ensure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the Terminal Removal Procedure. Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PULL TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL If the terminal is visibly damaged or is suspected of having a faulty connection, the terminal should be replaced. Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors: 1. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) device and/or the secondary lock. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component or separate the connectors for in-line connectors. 3. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device. 4. Insert the proper pick or removal tool into the front of the connector body. 5. IMPORTANT: On connectors with more than one terminal the service loop may not be large enough to remove the terminal and crimp on a new one. If the terminal wire does not have a large enough service loop for removal, cut the wire 5 cm (2 in) behind the connector before removal. Grasp the wire at the back of the connector body and gently push the terminal out the front of the connector body. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. If the wire needed to be cut in order to remove the terminal, gently push a small length of the same size wire through the back of the connector cavity until there is enough wire exposed in order to crimp on a new terminal. If the wire was not cut, cut the existing wire as close to the old terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 4. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. TERMINAL INSTALLATION 1. Align the terminal and pull the wire from the back of the connector in order to seat the terminal. 2. If necessary, cut the new wire to proper length and splice with existing circuit. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. 3. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply dielectric grease to the connector. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PUSH TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 2414 Page 3488 Frequently Asked Questions Disclaimer Locations Camshaft Position Sensor: Locations Engine Controls Component Views Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor 1 - Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor 2 - C110 Page 8513 MEASURING FREQUENCY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal. IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM to autorange to an appropriate range. 1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency measured. Measuring Voltage MEASURING VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit. 1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods: - Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. - Turn ON the engine. - Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls. - Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested. 3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The DMM displays the voltage measured at that point. Measuring Voltage Drop MEASURING VOLTAGE DROP NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points. Probing Electrical Connectors PROBING ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS Page 3830 Camshaft: Service and Repair Camshaft Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Remove the condenser. Refer to Condenser Replacement. 2. Remove the valve lifters from both cylinder heads. Refer to Valve Lifter Replacement. 3. Remove the camshaft sensor bolt and sensor. 4. Rotate the crankshaft until the timing marks on the crankshaft and camshaft sprockets are aligned. Page 3428 Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size. REPAIRING A FUSIBLE LINK IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient overload protection. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. Flat Wire Repairs FLAT WIRE REPAIRS NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced. GMLAN Wiring Repairs GMLAN WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The GM Local Area Network (GMLAN) System requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working on GMLAN connectors and terminals. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items in order to repair the GMLAN wiring: Dura Seal splice sleeves - A wire stripping tool - J 38125-8 Crimping Tool (GM P/N 12085115) - J 38125-5 Ultra Torch Special Tool (GM P/N 12085116) The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. - A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors GMLAN REPAIRS IMPORTANT: When making a repair to any GMLAN network, the original wire length after the repair must be the same length as before the repair. If the network is a twisted pair, the twist must be maintained after the repair is completed. GMLAN has 2 types of networks, low speed and high speed. Low speed GMLAN has a single wire and works at slow speeds. High speed GMLAN has 2 wires in a twisted pair and works at higher speeds. For more information on GMLAN, refer to Data Link Communications Description and Operation. GMLAN CONNECTOR TERMINAL REPAIR IMPORTANT: A service terminal can be used to replace damaged connector terminals for both high speed and low speed GMLAN systems. When making a connector terminal repair on a GMLAN high speed system with twisted pair wires, do not untwist the wires more than necessary to make the repair. The terminals in the GMLAN system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are available in the J-38125. If the individual terminals are damaged on any GMLAN connection, use the appropriate connector repair procedure in order to repair the terminal. GMLAN WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 3230 All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system. Page 6855 Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Diagrams Engine Controls Connector End Views Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor Page 7693 6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias. Reference the appropriate service manual wiring schematic to obtain the correct diode installation position. 7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for the soldering equipment. 8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed. 9. IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode attachment points with tape. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape. Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable SPLICING TWISTED OR SHIELDED CABLE Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable. 1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splice is made. 3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire. Staggering the splices by 65 mm (2.5 in) is recommended. 4. IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical contact with the drain wire. Re-assemble the cable. Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape. - Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1). - Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire. - Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape. Page 2038 6. Gently pry the plastic terminal retainer down and carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (16-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, pull the two connector halves apart. Page 1578 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (BSK) BOSCH CONNECTORS (BSK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 3. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 4. Insert the J 38125-561 tool into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 5. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is Page 1992 - Yazaki has a wedge or arrow shape, similar to that shown. Delphi Connectors (Micro .64) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro 64 connectors. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. The lever lock may be located on the top or sides of the wire dress cover. Page 6115 4. Slide the dress cover forward and off of the connector. 5. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front and rear of the connector. Page 4732 6. Heater outlet hose to engine (6). 7. Heater inlet hose to front of dash (7). 8. Heater outlet hose to front of dash (8). Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models) Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models) Page 7317 Page 725 4. Use a small flat-blade tool to slide the terminal position assurance (TPA) up one notch on both ends of the connector. The TPA is located underneath the wire dress cover. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 8581 Release the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the blue locking tabs on both ends of the connector. Gently slide the TPA up to the released position on both ends. 6. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-13A (GM P/N 12031876-1) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. Page 6958 If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the DuraSeal splice sleeves. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: - Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. - Do not use the crimp and DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 to crimp DuraSeal splice sleeve. In order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 1368 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 6458 2. Locate the two indents of the terminal position assurance (TPA) located on the bottom of the connector body. Page 6169 Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Service and Repair Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure Notice: Handle the electronic throttle control components carefully. Use cleanliness in order to prevent damage. Do not drop the electronic throttle control components. Do not roughly handle the electronic throttle control components. Do not immerse the electronic throttle control components in cleaning solvents of any type. 1. Disconnect the accelerator pedal position (APP) sensor electrical connector. 2. Remove the 3 APP sensor bolts (1). 3. Remove the APP sensor (2). Installation Procedure 1. Install the APP sensor. Page 2207 If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200 DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J 39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected. IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J 39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and maximum (MAX) values measured. 1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of a suspected circuit to the other. 2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J 39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep). IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value in order to record the full change. 5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling the connections or the wiring, test driving, or performing other operations. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions. 6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9. Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist. Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections TESTING FOR INTERMITTENT CONDITIONS AND POOR CONNECTIONS TOOLS REQUIRED - J 35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit - J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit When the condition is not currently present, but is indicated in DTC history, the cause may be intermittent. An intermittent may also be the cause when there is a customer complaint, but the symptom cannot be duplicated. Refer to the Symptom Table of the system that is suspect of causing the condition before trying to locate an intermittent condition. Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the following items: Wiring broken inside the insulation - Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector - Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself, and corrosion in the wire to terminal contact area, etc. - Pierced or damaged insulation can allow moisture to enter the wiring causing corrosion. The conductor can corrode inside the insulation, with little visible evidence. Look for swollen and stiff sections of wire in the suspect circuits. - Wiring which has been pinched, cut, or its insulation rubbed through may cause an intermittent open or short as the bare area touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle. - Wiring that comes in contact with hot or exhaust components - Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required, in order to verify the customer concern. - Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. - Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis and Vehicle Data Recorder operation. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any inline connectors before replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation. Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination, usually in the underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit. Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper adapter. Always use the J 35616 when probing connectors. Other causes of terminal deformation are improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT IN BUSSED ELECTRICAL CENTERS (BEC) Coolant Air Bleed Hose Replacement Cooling System Air Bleeder Pipe / Hose: Service and Repair Coolant Air Bleed Hose Replacement Coolant Air Bleed Hose Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Drain the cooling system, if necessary. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System (LL8) Draining and Filling Cooling System (LH6, LS2). 2. Reposition the coolant air bleed hose clamp at the coolant air bleed pipe. 3. Reposition the coolant air bleed hose clamp at the heater outlet hose. 4. Remove the coolant air bleed hose from the air bleed pipe and the heater hose. Installation Procedure 1. Install the coolant air bleed hose to the air bleed pipe and the heater hose. 2. Position the coolant air bleed hose clamp at the coolant air bleed pipe. Page 1423 Page 3487 Page 8885 Page 7131 Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagrams Engine Controls Connector End Views Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor Page 8164 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the TPA. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the nose piece. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. Page 352 All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system. Page 2651 Page 2301 Page 2484 5. Once the nose piece retainers are relaxed, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should raise slightly. 6. On the opposite side of the nose piece, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should release completely. If the nose piece does not come off, repeat the procedure on the opposite side. Page 1559 Utility/Van Zoning UTILITY/VAN ZONING Page 5739 breakers are used. CIRCUIT BREAKER This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high current is removed. POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) CIRCUIT BREAKER This type greatly increases its resistance when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker will re-close within a second or 2. Circuit Protection - Fuses CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSES The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and examine the element in the fuse for an open (2). If not broken (1), also check for continuity using a DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one of equal current rating. Circuit Protection - Fusible Links CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSIBLE LINKS Page 6293 Page 7374 2. Locate the two indents of the terminal position assurance (TPA) located on the bottom of the connector body. Page 7442 Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair Fuel Sender Assembly Replacement Fuel Sender Assembly Replacement Tools Required J45722 Fuel Tank Sending Unit Wrench Removal Procedure 1. Remove the fuel tank. 2. Remove the fuel feed (1) and EVAP (2) lines from the fuel sender assembly. Notice: Avoid damaging the lock ring. Use only J-45722 to prevent damage to the lock ring. Notice: Do Not handle the fuel sender assembly by the fuel pipes. The amount of leverage generated by handling the fuel pipes could damage the joints. Important: Do NOT use impact tools. Significant force will be required to release the lock ring. The use of a hammer and screwdriver is not recommended. Secure the fuel tank in order to prevent fuel tank rotation. 3. Use the J45722 and a long breaker-bar in order to unlock the fuel sender lock ring. Turn the fuel sender lock ring in a counterclockwise direction. Page 5109 8. Take a CLEAR digital picture of the Tech 2(R) Vehicle Information screen showing the engine Calibration IDs and Verification Numbers as shown above. Retain the printout information and the Tech 2(R) screen photograph with the repair order. 9. E-mail a copy of the picture to [email protected]. In the subject line of the e-mail include the phrase "V8 Cal" as well as the complete VIN and Dealer BAC. In the body of the e-mail, include the VIN, mileage, R.O. number and BAC. Include a brief description of the customer concern and cause of the concern. Note The dealer will receive an e-mail reply after the calibrations have been validated. The e-mail reply will advise the dealer if the calibrations are OEM. 10. Allow two hours for the PQC to verify the calibrations and set up the case details. ‹› If the PQC determines that the calibrations ARE aftermarket calibrations, DO NOT contact GM Technical Assistance to discuss warranty concerns on the aftermarket calibrations. ALL questions and concerns about warranty should be directed to the dealers Fixed Operations Manager (FOM), (Warranty Manager (WM) in Canada). 11. You may call the PQC two hours after submitting the e-mail for authorization to replace the assembly. This will provide them time to receive, review and set up a case on the request. Please be prepared to provide all the usual documentation that is normally required when requesting an assembly authorization from the PQC. Tech 2(R) Displaying All Zeroes for the Verification Numbers on the Calibration ID and Verification Number Screen If the Tech 2(R) that you are using displays all zeroes for the Verification Numbers as shown, then perform the following steps: 1. Update the Tech 2(R) with the latest software from TIS2WEB. 2. Turn OFF the ignition for 90 seconds. 3. Connect the Tech 2(R) to the vehicle. 4. Turn ON the ignition, and build the vehicle. Observe the Tech 2(R) Calibration ID and Verification Number screen for proper operation. ‹› If the Tech 2(R) screen still does not display properly, then turn OFF the ignition for 90 seconds again. Turn ON the ignition and observe the same screen for proper operation. Retrieving Calibrations From a Global A Vehicle This information applies to the 2010 Camaro and is typical of the procedure that will be used on Global A vehicles. 1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Connect the MDI to the Data Link Connector (DLC) of the vehicle. Note Use the USB port to make the following MDI connection: Locations Crankshaft Position Sensor: Locations Engine Controls Component Views Lower Right Side of the Engine - Rear 1 - Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor 2 - Knock Sensor (KS) 2 - Right 3 - Engine Harness 4 Starter 5 - Engine Page 4888 vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide variety of actions, including: - Wiggling the harness - Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting - Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector - Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation - Relocating a harness or wires All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. Another option is, with the component commanded ON and OFF by the scan tool, move related connectors and wiring and observe the component operation. With the engine running, move related connectors and wiring while monitoring engine operation. If harness or connector movement affects the data displayed, component/system operation, or engine operation, inspect and repair the harness/connections as necessary. You may need to load the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these cases you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide good results as well. There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions, along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the circuit to these kinds of conditions. SALT WATER SPRAY Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture. Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5 percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously. HIGH TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070. Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault condition. The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis. This option does not allow for the same control, however. LOW TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect. If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to -18°C (0°F) from one end and +71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized cooling needs. Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or components in an effort to duplicate the concern. DUPLICATING FAILURE CONDITIONS - If none of the previous tests are successful, attempt to duplicate and/or capture the failure conditions. Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, where applicable, contains the conditions that were present when the DTC set. 1. Review and record Freeze Frame/Failure Records data. 2. Clear the DTCs using the scan tool. 3. Turn the key to OFF and wait 15 seconds. 4. Operate the vehicle under the same conditions that were noted in Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, as closely as possible. The vehicle must also be operating within the Conditions for Running the DTC. Refer to Conditions for Running the DTC in the supporting text if a DTC is being diagnosed. 5. Monitor DTC Status for the DTC being tested. The scan tool will indicate Ran, when the enabling conditions have been satisfied long enough for the DTC to run. The scan tool will also indicate whether the DTC passed or failed. - An alternate method is to drive the vehicle with the DMM connected to a suspected circuit. An abnormal reading on the DMM when the concern occurs, may help you locate the concern. Measuring Frequency Page 7688 If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the DuraSeal splice sleeves. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: - Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. - Do not use the crimp and DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 to crimp DuraSeal splice sleeve. In order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 2022 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 3231 Fuse: Diagnostic Aids Arrows and Symbols Arrows and Symbols This Service Data uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations. Arrows and Symbols 1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow Basic Knowledge Required GENERAL ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures contained in the service manual. You should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current (amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram, as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. Decimal and Metric Equivalents Decimal and Metric Equivalents Page 2599 Release the lower wiredress cover locking tab. Release the upper wiredress cover locking tab. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. Page 8229 OnStar(R) - Aftermarket Device Interference Information Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Aftermarket Device Interference Information INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 08-08-46-004 Date: August 14, 2008 Subject: Information on Aftermarket Device Interference with OnStar(R) Diagnostic Services Models: 2009 and Prior GM Passenger Car and Truck (including Saturn) 2009 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3 Models 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X with OnStar(R) (RPO UE1) This bulletin is being issued to provide dealer service personnel with information regarding aftermarket devices connected to the Diagnostic Link Connector (DLC) and the impact to OnStar(R) diagnostic probes and Vehicle Diagnostic e-mails. Certain aftermarket devices, when connected to the Diagnostic Link Connector, such as, but not limited to, Scan Tools, Trip Computers, Fuel Economy Analyzers and Insurance Tracking Devices, interfere with OnStar's ability to perform a diagnostic probe when requested (via a blue button call) by a subscriber. These devices also prohibit the ability to gather diagnostic and tire pressure data for a subscriber's scheduled OnStar(R) Vehicle Diagnostic (OVD) e-mail. These aftermarket devices utilize the Vehicles serial data bus to perform data requests and/or information gathering. When these devices are requesting data, OnStar(R) is designed not to interfere with any data request being made by these devices as required by OBD II regulations. The OnStar(R) advisor is unable to definitively detect the presence of these devices and will only be able to inform the caller or requester of the unsuccessful or incomplete probe and may in some cases refer the subscriber/requester to take the vehicle to a dealer for diagnosis of the concern. When performing a diagnostic check for an unsuccessful or incomplete OnStar(R) diagnostic probe, or for concerns regarding completeness of the OnStar(R) Vehicle Diagnostic (OVD) e-mail, verify that an aftermarket device was not present at the time of the requested probe. Regarding the OVD e-mail, if an aftermarket device is interfering (including a Scan Tool of any type), the e-mail will consistently display a "yellow" indication in diagnostics section for all vehicle systems except the OnStar(R) System and Tire Pressure data (not available on all vehicles) will not be displayed (i.e. section is collapsed). Successful diagnostic probes and complete OVD e-mails will resume following the removal or disconnecting of the off-board device. Disclaimer Page 246 5. While pushing the terminal forward, insert the J 38125-24 in the release cavity above the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (43-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Page 6687 Depress the locks that are located on both sides of the wiredress cover and pull the lever over and past the locks. View of the connector when released from the component. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the front of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool push down on one of the locking tabs and pull the cover up until the dress cover releases. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. Page 9006 Checking Aftermarket Accessories CHECKING AFTERMARKET ACCESSORIES Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits: - CAUTION: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol. - NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice. OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol. Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the cause of the problems. Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include: Power feeds connected to points other than the battery - Antenna location - Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring - Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line - Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories. Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions INDUCING INTERMITTENT FAULT CONDITIONS TOOLS REQUIRED J 25070 Heat Gun Many intermittent open or shorted circuits are affected by harness/connector movement that is caused by vibration, engine torque, bumps/rough pavement, etc. In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness if the malfunction appears to be Page 7006 Utility/Van Zoning UTILITY/VAN ZONING Page 1694 Page 8461 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link). - The wire insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. 5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold them between thumb and forefinger. 7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place. - Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction. - Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip. 8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool closes.Ensure that no strands of wire are cut. 10. Crimp the splice on each end (2). Page 673 Page 8598 11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the solder equipment. 12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. 13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to cover the first piece of tape. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE SLEEVES TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit IMPORTANT: Use only dura seal splice sleeves. Other splice sleeves may not protect the splice from moisture or provide a good electrical connection. Use duraseal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. Use duraseal splice sleeves where there is special requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire using duraseal splice sleeves. Page 9013 It is very important to use the correct test adapter when testing for proper terminal contact of fuses and relays in a bussed electrical center (BEC). Use J-35616-35 to test for proper terminal contact. Failure to use J-35616-35 can result in improper diagnosis of the BEC. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Separate the connector halves. 2. Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body. 3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J-38125 , test that the retention force is significantly different between a good terminal and a suspect terminal. Replace the female terminal in question. FLAT WIRE (DOCK AND LOCK) CONNECTORS There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock) connectors on the harness side or the component side. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Remove the component in question. 2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side of the connector as oil from your skin may be a source of contamination as well. 3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other imperfections that could cause poor terminal contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are uniform and free of damage or deformation. 4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the on the flat wire harness connector in order to test the circuit in question. CONTROL MODULE/COMPONENT VOLTAGE AND GROUNDS Poor voltage or ground connections can cause widely varying symptoms. Test all control module voltage supply circuits. Many vehicles have multiple circuits supplying voltage to a control module. Other components in the system may have separate voltage supply circuits that may also need to be tested. Inspect connections at the module/component connectors, fuses, and any intermediate connections between the voltage source and the module/component. A test lamp or a DMM may indicate that voltage is present, but neither tests the ability of the circuit to carry sufficient current. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Power Distribution Schematics. - Test all control module ground and system ground circuits. The control module may have multiple ground circuits. Other components in the system may have separate grounds that may also need to be tested. Inspect grounds for clean and tight connections at the grounding point. Inspect the connections at the component and in splice packs, where applicable. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Ground Distribution Schematics. TEMPERATURE SENSITIVITY - An intermittent condition may occur when a component/connection reaches normal operating temperature. The condition may occur only when the component/connection is cold, or only when the component/connection is hot. - Freeze Frame, Failure Records, Snapshot, or Vehicle Data Recorder data may help with this type of intermittent condition, where applicable. - If the intermittent is related to heat, review the data for a relationship with the following: High ambient temperatures - Underhood/engine generated heat - Circuit generated heat due to a poor connection, or high electrical load - Higher than normal load conditions, towing, etc. - If the intermittent is related to cold, review the data for the following: Low ambient temperatures-In extremely low temperatures, ice may form in a connection or component. Inspect for water intrusion. - The condition only occurs on a cold start. - The condition goes away when the vehicle warms up. - Information from the customer may help to determine if the trouble follows a pattern that is temperature related. - If temperature is suspected of causing an intermittent fault condition, attempt to duplicate the condition. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required. ELECTROMAGNETIC INTERFERENCE (EMI) AND ELECTRICAL NOISE Some electrical components/circuits are sensitive to electromagnetic interference (EMI) or other types of electrical noise. Inspect for the following conditions: A misrouted harness that is too close to high voltage/high current devices such as secondary ignition components, motors, generator etc-These components may induce electrical noise on a circuit that could interfere with normal circuit operation. - Electrical system interference caused by a malfunctioning relay, or a control module driven solenoid or switch-These conditions can cause a sharp electrical surge. Normally, the condition will occur when the malfunctioning component is operating. - Improper installation of non-factory or aftermarket add on accessories such as lights, 2-way radios, amplifiers, electric motors, remote starters, alarm systems, cell phones, etc-These accessories may lead to interference while in use, but do not fail when the accessories are not in use. - Test for an open diode across the A/C compressor clutch and for other open diodes. Some relays may contain a clamping diode. - The generator may be allowing AC noise into the electrical system. INCORRECT CONTROL MODULE - There are only a few situations where reprogramming a control module is appropriate: A new service control module is installed. Page 6747 5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape. Seat Belt Schematic Icons Seat Belt Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons Page 2929 Drive Belt: Service Precautions Belt Dressing Notice Notice: Do not use belt dressing on the drive belt. Belt dressing causes the breakdown of the composition of the drive belt. Failure to follow this recommendation will damage the drive belt. Page 1321 Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. For connectors with a bolt in the dress cover, turn the bolt counterclockwise to remove the connector from the component. 2. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. Page 6132 2. Use a small flat-bladed tool to release the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting the tool in the small recess on the side of the connector and pushing up until the TPA releases from the connector body. The TPA should raise just slightly. Do not try to remove the TPA. IMPORTANT: The TPA on this connector cannot be removed unless the terminals are removed first. The TPA will come out of the connector body, but only slightly. When the TPA is slightly raised the terminals can be removed. Using excessive force to remove the TPA with the terminals still in the connector will damage the connector. 3. Repeat the process for the other side of the connector. 4. Ensure that the TPA is in the proper position to remove the terminals. Service and Repair Thermostat Housing: Service and Repair Water Outlet Housing Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Disconnect the radiator inlet hose from the water outlet housing. Refer to Radiator Outlet Hose Replacement (LH6, LS2) Radiator Outlet Hose Replacement (LL8). 2. Remove the power steering pump bracket. Refer to Power Steering Pump Bracket Replacement. 3. Remove the water outlet housing bolts. 4. Remove the water outlet housing and seal. Discard the old seal. Installation Procedure 1. Remove any burrs or foreign material from the sealing surface of the engine cylinder head and the water outlet housing. 2. Install a NEW seal and the water outlet housing. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 3. Install the water outlet housing bolts. Tighten the water outlet bolts to 10 N.m (89 lb in). 4. Connect the radiator inlet hose to the water outlet housing. Refer to Radiator Outlet Hose Replacement (LH6, LS2) Radiator Outlet Hose Replacement (LL8). 5. Install the power steering pump bracket. Refer to Power Steering Pump Bracket Replacement. Page 6381 Open the harness by removing any tape. 2. Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. 3. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 4. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent american wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 5. Slide a section of high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing down the length of wire to be spliced. Ensure that the shrink tubing will not interfere with the splice procedure. 6. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 7. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. 8. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 9. Insert the wire into the DuraSeal splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 10. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Page 2518 Page 3410 5. Once the nose piece retainers are relaxed, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should raise slightly. 6. On the opposite side of the nose piece, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should release completely. If the nose piece does not come off, repeat the procedure on the opposite side. Page 739 5. Once the nose piece retainers are relaxed, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should raise slightly. 6. On the opposite side of the nose piece, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should release completely. If the nose piece does not come off, repeat the procedure on the opposite side. Page 3409 3. Remove the dress cover by using a flat-blade tool to release the connector locking tabs and pulling off the dress cover. 4. Relieve the tension on the nose piece retainers by inserting J-38125-12A (12094429) into the single retainer slot on the end of the nose piece and gently prying out the locking tab. Repeat the process for both of the nose piece locking tabs on the opposite side of the nose piece. Page 6607 If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs SIR/SRS WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS, and the wiring components, such as connectors and terminals. IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system terminals. Use either an SIR/SRS pigtail or a terminated lead from the SIR Repair Kit Tray. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves, in order to repair the SIR/SRS wiring - A special crimping tool - A heat torch - An instruction manual The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides the necessary low resistance contact integrity for these sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors SIR/SRS CONNECTOR REPAIR (PLASTIC BODY AND TERMINAL METAL PIN) The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made with a special plating. This plating provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. Use the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit for repairing SIR/SRS terminals and connectors. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the repair kit. The J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit contains: Various terminated leads for sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) terminal replacement - Various connector positive assurance (CPA) locks for SIR/SRS connectors - Base of steering column pigtail connectors part number 12085514 - Yellow vinyl electrical tape Pigtail repair packs are available for SIR/SRS connectors with eight or less terminals. Only the connector body is available for connectors with more than eight terminals. The terminated leads in the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit can be used to replace damaged terminals when replacing the connector body. SIR/SRS COMPONENT WIRE PIGTAIL REPAIR IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails. A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device, not by a connector. If a wiring pigtail is damaged, you must replace the entire component, with pigtail. The inflatable restraint steering wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component. SIR/SRS WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 5750 11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the solder equipment. 12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. 13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to cover the first piece of tape. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE SLEEVES TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit IMPORTANT: Use only dura seal splice sleeves. Other splice sleeves may not protect the splice from moisture or provide a good electrical connection. Use duraseal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. Use duraseal splice sleeves where there is special requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire using duraseal splice sleeves. Page 8757 Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Heated Oxygen Sensor Replacement - Bank 2 Sensor 1 Heated Oxygen Sensor Replacement - Bank 2 Sensor 1 Removal Procedure Notice: Refer to Heated Oxygen and Oxygen Sensor Notice. Notice: Refer to Excessive Force and Oxygen Sensor Notice. 1. Raise and suitably support the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Unscrew the heated oxygen sensor (HO2S) sensor from the catalytic converter. 3. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) retainer. 4. Disconnect the HO2S electrical connector (2). Installation Procedure Page 2098 Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. For connectors with a bolt in the dress cover, turn the bolt counterclockwise to remove the connector from the component. 2. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. Page 24 THIS PROGRAM IS IN EFFECT UNTIL APRIL 30, 2011. Condition Certain 2002-2009 model year vehicles equipped with OnStar(R) may have a condition in which the vehicle's OnStar(R) system repeatedly makes incomplete calls to OnStar(R) without the vehicle's occupant(s) input or knowledge. Customer initiated Blue Button call, Emergency calls, and Automatic Crash Notification calls will also fail to establish a data connection with the OnStar(R) Call Center. Eventually, the customer's call will connect as a voice only line and the customer will be able to talk with an OnStar(R) advisor; however, the advisor will not get crucial customer data such as vehicle identification and location. Correction Dealers/retailers are to replace the OnStar(R) module (VCIM). Vehicles Involved Involved are certain 2002-2009 model year vehicles equipped with OnStar(R), and built within these VIN breakpoints: Note: Some model years/models have only one vehicle involved. Important Dealers/retailers are to confirm vehicle eligibility prior to beginning repairs by using GMVIS (dealers/retailers using WINS) or the Investigate Vehicle History link (dealers/retailers using GWM). Not all vehicles within the above breakpoints may be involved. For dealers/retailers with involved vehicles, a listing with involved vehicles containing the complete vehicle identification number, customer name, and address information has been prepared and will be provided to dealers/retailers through the GM GlobalConnect Recall Reports. Dealers/retailers will not have a report available if they have no involved vehicles currently assigned. The listing may contain customer names and addresses obtained from Motor Vehicle Registration Records. The use of such motor vehicle registration data for any purpose other than follow-up necessary to complete this program is a violation of law in several states/provinces/countries. Accordingly, you are urged to limit the use of this report to the follow-up necessary to complete this program. Parts Information US: OnStar(R) modules required for this program are to be obtained by contacting Autocraft Electronics via the web at www.autocraft.com, and selecting the catalog item that contains bulletin number 10037 (or PIC 4893B), or by calling 1-800-336-3998. Dealer must provide the VIN, R.O. number, and the current vehicle mileage. Canada: OnStar(R) modules required for this program are to be obtained by contacting MASS Electronics at 1-877-410-6277. Dealer must provide the VIN, R.O. number, and the current vehicle mileage. DO NOT ORDER ONSTAR(R) MODULES FROM GENERAL MOTORS CUSTOMER CARE AND AFTERSALES (GMCC&A;), SATURN SERVICE PARTS OPERATION (SSPO), OR THE TECHNICAL ASSISTANCE CENTER (TAC). Courtesy Transportation The General Motors Courtesy Transportation program is intended to minimize customer inconvenience when a vehicle requires a repair that is covered by the New Vehicle Limited Warranties. The availability of courtesy transportation to customers whose vehicles are within the warranty coverage period and involved in a product program is very important in maintaining customer satisfaction. Dealers/retailers are to ensure that these customers understand that shuttle service or some other form of courtesy transportation is available and will be provided at no charge. Dealers should refer to the General Motors Service Policies and Procedures Manual for Courtesy Transportation guidelines. Claim Information 1. Submit a claim using the table below. 2. Courtesy Transportation - For dealers/retailers using WINS, submit using normal labor code; for dealers/retailers using GWM - submit as Net Item under the repair labor code. Page 809 Page 8646 All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system. Engine - Drive Belt Misalignment Diagnostics Drive Belt: Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Drive Belt Misalignment Diagnostics INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 08-06-01-008A Date: July 27, 2009 Subject: Diagnosing Accessory Drive Belt / Serpentine Belt Noise and Availability and Use of Kent-Moore EN-49228 Laser Alignment Tool - Drive Belt Models: 2010 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3 Vehicles 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add a model year and update the Tool Information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 08-06-01-008 (Section 06 - Engine). Background Several aftermarket companies offer laser alignment tools for accessory drive systems that can be very helpful in eliminating drive belt noise as a result of misaligned pulleys. Typically pricing ranges from $160 - $200. EN-49228 Laser Alignment Tool - Drive Belt The GM Tool program has now made available a competitive, simple to use and time-saving laser tool to assist in achieving precise alignment of the drive belt pulleys. This optional tool removes the guesswork from proper pulley alignment and may serve to reduce comebacks from: - Drive Belt Noise - Accelerated Drive Belt Wear - Drive Belt Slippage Instructions The instructions below are specific only to the truck Gen IV V-8 family of engines. These instructions are only for illustrative purposes to show how the tool may be used. Universal instructions are included in the box with the Laser Alignment Tool - Drive Belt. Caution - Do not look directly into the beam projected from the laser. - Use caution when shining the laser on highly polished or reflective surfaces. Laser safety glasses help reduce laser beam glare in many circumstances. - Always use laser safety glasses when using the laser. Laser safety glasses are not designed to protect eyes from direct laser exposure. 1. Observe and mark the serpentine belt orientation. Page 3843 Allow at least a two hour soak time between engine OFF and start up when evaluating the tick noise. 2. Start the engine and evaluate the valve lifter tick noise. ‹› If the valve lifter tick noise is still present, replace all 16 valve lifters. Refer to Valve Lifter Replacement in SI. Parts Information Note A V8 AFM engine requires 8 AFM lifters and 8 non-AFM lifters for a total of 16 lifters. Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use: Warranty Information (Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 2839 Important When performing adjustments to vehicles requiring a 4-wheel alignment, set the rear wheel alignment angles first in order to obtain proper front wheel alignment angles. Perform the following steps in order to measure the front and rear alignment angles: 1. Install the alignment equipment according to the manufacturer's instructions. 2. Jounce the front and the rear bumpers 3 times prior to checking the wheel alignment. 3. Measure the alignment angles and record the readings. If necessary, adjust the wheel alignment to vehicle specification and record the before and after measurements. Refer to Wheel Alignment Specifications in SI. Important Technicians must refer to SI for the correct wheel alignment specifications. SI is the only source of GM wheel alignment specifications that is kept up-to-date throughout the year. Test drive vehicle to ensure proper repair. Page 411 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry one side of the nose piece up to the pre-stage position. When the nose piece is in the pre-staged position, the nose piece will be raised above the connector body the length of the step in the nose piece. 7. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry the other side of the piece to the pre-stage position. If the nose piece is higher than the first step in the nose piece, gently push down on the nose piece until it meets with resistance from the connector body, you should feel the nose piece click into position. Page 3766 View of typical connector. View of connector in released position. 1. Locate the assist lever at the back of the connector. Move the assist lever to the rear position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the dress cover. Page 243 6. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by pressing on the tang. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (SENSOR) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) tool into the cavity on the lower right hand face of the connector until the terminal release tang access panel slides over. Engine Controls - MIL ON/Misfire/Misfire DTC's Set Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL ON/Misfire/Misfire DTC's Set Bulletin No.: 06-06-04-046 Date: September 12, 2006 INFORMATION Subject: Information on Engine Misfire MIL/SES Light Illuminated or Flashing DTC P0300, P0301, P0302, P0303, P0304, P0305, P0306, P0307, P0308, P0420 or P0430 Models: 1999-2007 Cadillac, Chevrolet, GMC Full-Size Pickup and/or Utility Trucks with 4.8L, 5.3L, 5.7L, 6.0L or 6.2L VORTEC GEN III, GEN IV, V-8 Engine (VINs V, C, T, Z, B, 3, M, 0, J, R, U, N, Y, K, 8 - RPOs LR4, LY2, LM7, L59, L33, LC9, LH6, LMG, LY5, L31, LQ4, LQ9, L76, LY6, L92) with Active Fuel Management(TM) and E85 Flex Fuel If you encounter vehicles that exhibit the above conditions, refer to SI for the appropriate DTC(s) set. If no trouble is found, the cause may be due to an ECM ground terminal that has corroded with rust over time. Inspect the main engine wiring harness ground terminal (G103) for this condition. The wire terminal (G103) attaches either to the front or to the rear of the right side cylinder head, depending on the model year of the Full Size Pickup and/or Utility Trucks. If the ECM ground terminal has been found to be corroded, then follow the service procedure outlined in this bulletin to correct the corrosion issue. Remove either the nut or bolt securing the main engine wiring harness ground terminal (G103) to the right cylinder head. Refer to the above illustration to determine where the ground is located on the vehicle (1). Page 3318 If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the DuraSeal splice sleeves. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: - Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. - Do not use the crimp and DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 to crimp DuraSeal splice sleeve. In order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 6181 Page 7089 If a wire is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm, etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except coaxial. - Do not use the DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent American wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 225 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully raise the TPA on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA cannot be removed from the connector while there are terminals present in the connector body. View of the TPA when removed from the connector body. 4. Use the J 38125-12A tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the left side of the terminal release cavity as shown in the graphic. Use the tool to move the terminal release to the right with a gentle prying motion. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 723 Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. FCI Connectors FCI CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 2407 Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Camshaft Position Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Remove the generator bracket assembly. 2. Remove the camshaft position sensor mounting bolts (1). 3. Remove the camshaft position sensor assembly (4, 5, 6) from the front cover (7). 4. Disconnect the camshaft position sensor jumper harness (2) and the engine harness (3) electrical connectors. 5. Remove the camshaft sensor assembly (4, 5, 6). 6. Disconnect camshaft position sensor (5) from the jumper harness (4). Installation Procedure 1. Reconnect the camshaft sensor (5) and the jumper harness (4). 2. Install the O-ring (6) on the camshaft sensor assembly (4, 5). 3. Reconnect the camshaft position sensor assembly (4, 5, 6) and the engine harness connector (3). Page 4790 Release the tabs that are holding the wiredress cover to the connector body. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the slots on both ends of the connector body. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. J 38125-216 can also be used to remove the nose piece. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by lifting the terminal retaining tabs on the inside of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 8537 - Most Molex connectors will have the Molex logo on the dresscover of the connector. In some cases the connectors may have MX followed by another letter. The third letter indicates where the connector was made. A connector with MXD is a Molex connector made in Detroit. Sumitomo has a unique symbol on their connector and possibly a part number. The symbol is similar to that of a diamond lying on its side, similar to that shown. The logo could appear anywhere but the most common place is at the wire side of the housing. Tyco/AMP has many different and unique connector designs. Some may or may not have identifiable marks on them. Page 6502 US English/Metric Conversion US English/Metric Conversion Page 8829 MOLEX CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. 2. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. Page 7645 Release the lower wiredress cover locking tab. Release the upper wiredress cover locking tab. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. Page 1855 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. 4. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front of the connector. Page 7741 Page 6877 IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals. Front probe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the connector. IMPORTANT: When probing female 0.64 terminals, it is important to use the correct adapter. There have been some revisions to the test adapter for 0.64 terminals. The proper adapter for 0.64 terminals is the J 35616-64B which has a gold terminal and a black wire between the base and tip. Failure to use the proper test adapter may result in damage to the terminal being tested and improper diagnosis. NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Page 230 MOLEX CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. 2. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. Page 168 Page 7327 Checking Aftermarket Accessories CHECKING AFTERMARKET ACCESSORIES Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits: - CAUTION: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol. - NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice. OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol. Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the cause of the problems. Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include: Power feeds connected to points other than the battery - Antenna location - Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring - Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line - Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories. Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions INDUCING INTERMITTENT FAULT CONDITIONS TOOLS REQUIRED J 25070 Heat Gun Many intermittent open or shorted circuits are affected by harness/connector movement that is caused by vibration, engine torque, bumps/rough pavement, etc. In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness if the malfunction appears to be Page 4868 US English/Metric Conversion US English/Metric Conversion Page 2465 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) and slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. Page 1842 IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals. Front probe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the connector. IMPORTANT: When probing female 0.64 terminals, it is important to use the correct adapter. There have been some revisions to the test adapter for 0.64 terminals. The proper adapter for 0.64 terminals is the J 35616-64B which has a gold terminal and a black wire between the base and tip. Failure to use the proper test adapter may result in damage to the terminal being tested and improper diagnosis. NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Page 3592 Do not use cleaning solutions that contain hydrofluoric, oxalic and most other acids on chrome wheels (or any wheels). If the customer is unsure of the chemical make-up of a particular wheel cleaner, it should be avoided. For wheels showing signs of milky staining from acidic cleaners, refer to Customer Assistance and Instructions below. Warranty of Stained Chrome Wheels Stained wheels are not warrantable. Most acid based cleaners will permanently stain chrome wheels. Follow-up with dealers has confirmed that such cleaners were used on wheels that were returned to the Warranty Parts Center (WPC). Any stained wheels received by the WPC will be charged back to the dealership. To assist the customer, refer to Customer Assistance and Instructions below. Pitting or Spotted Appearance of Chrome Wheels Figure 2 A second type or staining or finish disturbance may result from road chemicals, such as calcium chloride used for dust control of unpaved roads. The staining will look like small pitting (refer to Figure 2). This staining will usually be on the leading edges of each wheel spoke, but may be uniformly distributed. If a vehicle must be operated under such conditions, the chrome wheels should be washed with mild soap and water and thoroughly rinsed as soon as conveniently possible. Important Road chemicals, such as calcium chloride used for dust control of unpaved roads, can also stain chrome wheels. The staining will look like small pitting. This staining will usually be on the leading edges of each wheel spoke. This is explained by the vehicle traveling in the forward direction while being splashed by the road chemical. If a vehicle must be operated under such conditions, the chrome wheels should be washed with mild soap and water and thoroughly rinsed as soon as conveniently possible. Warranty of Pitted or Spotted Chrome Wheels Wheels returned with pitting or spotting as a result of road chemicals may be replaced one time. Damage resulting from contact with these applied road chemicals is corrosive to the wheels finish and may cause damage if the wheels are not kept clean. Important Notify the customer that this is a one time replacement. Please stress to the customer the vital importance of keeping the wheels clean if they are operating the vehicle in an area that applies calcium chloride or other dust controlling chemicals! "GM of Canada" dealers require prior approval by the District Manager - Customer Care and Service Process (DM-CCSP). "Stardust" Corrosion of Chrome Wheels Figure 3 A third type of finish disturbance results from prolonged exposure to brake dust and resultant penetration of brake dust through the chrome. As brakes are applied hot particles of brake material are thrown off and tend to be forced through the leading edge of the wheel spoke windows by airflow. These Page 8237 vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide variety of actions, including: - Wiggling the harness - Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting - Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector - Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation - Relocating a harness or wires All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. Another option is, with the component commanded ON and OFF by the scan tool, move related connectors and wiring and observe the component operation. With the engine running, move related connectors and wiring while monitoring engine operation. If harness or connector movement affects the data displayed, component/system operation, or engine operation, inspect and repair the harness/connections as necessary. You may need to load the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these cases you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide good results as well. There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions, along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the circuit to these kinds of conditions. SALT WATER SPRAY Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture. Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5 percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously. HIGH TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070. Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault condition. The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis. This option does not allow for the same control, however. LOW TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect. If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to -18°C (0°F) from one end and +71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized cooling needs. Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or components in an effort to duplicate the concern. DUPLICATING FAILURE CONDITIONS - If none of the previous tests are successful, attempt to duplicate and/or capture the failure conditions. Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, where applicable, contains the conditions that were present when the DTC set. 1. Review and record Freeze Frame/Failure Records data. 2. Clear the DTCs using the scan tool. 3. Turn the key to OFF and wait 15 seconds. 4. Operate the vehicle under the same conditions that were noted in Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, as closely as possible. The vehicle must also be operating within the Conditions for Running the DTC. Refer to Conditions for Running the DTC in the supporting text if a DTC is being diagnosed. 5. Monitor DTC Status for the DTC being tested. The scan tool will indicate Ran, when the enabling conditions have been satisfied long enough for the DTC to run. The scan tool will also indicate whether the DTC passed or failed. - An alternate method is to drive the vehicle with the DMM connected to a suspected circuit. An abnormal reading on the DMM when the concern occurs, may help you locate the concern. Measuring Frequency Page 7267 Remove all rust from the ground terminal, the cylinder head and the retaining nut or bolt. Position the main engine wiring harness ground terminal and install the nut or bolt. Tighten: Tighten the retaining nut or bolt to 16 N.m (12 lb ft). Apply some type of electrical moisture sealant to protect the harness terminal from further corrosion. Disclaimer Page 8555 REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. The release tab is located on the top of the wiredress cover. View of connector in released position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Page 5169 IMPORTANT: Ensure that the dress cover and connector body are both in the released position before reassembling. Failure to do so may cause damage to the connector and component. Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (0.64) BOSCH CONNECTORS (0.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While pressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock until the lever is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Pull the rubber boot that covers the wires back to expose the end of the connector dress cover. 4. Place the connector locking lever in the center of the connector. 5. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs that are on the wire end of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover and connector body and pry up. Page 5949 3. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. View showing depressing of the lever lock release tab. Page 8134 View of connector in released position. 4. Disconnect the connector from the component. 5. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Release the rear lower half of the wiredress cover. Page 1998 The first connector design of the Micro-Pack 100W (1) has a white connector interface that holds the terminals. The second design of the Micro-Pack 100W (2) has a gray interface to hold the terminals. Also, the first design has terminal cavities that are further apart (3 mm centerline) and offset from the other row of terminal cavities in the connector. The second design has terminals cavities that are closer together (2.54 mm centerline) and aligned vertically. One other way to identify the second design is the thin strip of material that runs along the outside of the cavities. IMPORTANT: There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W terminals which are very similar. Ensure that you have the correct terminal before crimping the new terminal to the wire. The first design connector uses the longer terminal (1) that has a raised area in front of the recess in the terminal. The second design connector uses the shorter terminal without the raised area. Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro-Pack 100W connectors. Some Micro-Pack 100W connector disassembly procedures will vary. Use this procedure as a guide. 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. Engine - Low Oil Lamp ON/Oil Leaks Oil Pressure Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Low Oil Lamp ON/Oil Leaks TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 07-06-01-004A Date: November 25, 2008 Subject: All Vortec(R) GEN IV V8 Engines - LY2 LS4 LC9 LH6 LMG LY5 LS2 L76 LY6 L92 LS7, Low Oil Level Indicator Lamp On and/or Engine Oil Leak (Reseal Oil Pressure Sensor) Models Supercede: This bulletin is being updated to include a labor operation number for CTS-V and Corvette models. Please discard Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 07-06-01-004 (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System). Condition Some customers may comment on a low oil level indicator lamp on and/or engine oil leak. Upon further investigation, the technician may find that the oil leak is at the oil pressure sensor that is threaded into the valve lifter oil manifold (VLOM) assembly and/or engine valley cover. Correction If the engine oil leak was found to be at the engine oil pressure sensor, then remove the oil pressure sensor and reseal with a pipe sealant with Teflon or equivalent, P/N 12346004 (in Canada, P/N 10953480). Refer to Engine Oil Pressure Sensor and/or Switch Replacement in SI. Parts Information Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models) Page 2089 vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide variety of actions, including: - Wiggling the harness - Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting - Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector - Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation - Relocating a harness or wires All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. Another option is, with the component commanded ON and OFF by the scan tool, move related connectors and wiring and observe the component operation. With the engine running, move related connectors and wiring while monitoring engine operation. If harness or connector movement affects the data displayed, component/system operation, or engine operation, inspect and repair the harness/connections as necessary. You may need to load the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these cases you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide good results as well. There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions, along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the circuit to these kinds of conditions. SALT WATER SPRAY Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture. Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5 percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously. HIGH TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070. Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault condition. The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis. This option does not allow for the same control, however. LOW TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect. If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to -18°C (0°F) from one end and +71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized cooling needs. Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or components in an effort to duplicate the concern. DUPLICATING FAILURE CONDITIONS - If none of the previous tests are successful, attempt to duplicate and/or capture the failure conditions. Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, where applicable, contains the conditions that were present when the DTC set. 1. Review and record Freeze Frame/Failure Records data. 2. Clear the DTCs using the scan tool. 3. Turn the key to OFF and wait 15 seconds. 4. Operate the vehicle under the same conditions that were noted in Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, as closely as possible. The vehicle must also be operating within the Conditions for Running the DTC. Refer to Conditions for Running the DTC in the supporting text if a DTC is being diagnosed. 5. Monitor DTC Status for the DTC being tested. The scan tool will indicate Ran, when the enabling conditions have been satisfied long enough for the DTC to run. The scan tool will also indicate whether the DTC passed or failed. - An alternate method is to drive the vehicle with the DMM connected to a suspected circuit. An abnormal reading on the DMM when the concern occurs, may help you locate the concern. Measuring Frequency Page 1503 If a wire is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm, etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except coaxial. - Do not use the DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent American wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Locations Headlamp Switch Page 1642 If a wire is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm, etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except coaxial. - Do not use the DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent American wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 1406 Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair Mass Airflow Sensor/Intake Air Temperature Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure Important: Use care when handling the mass air flow (MAF)/intake air temperature (IAT) sensor. Do not dent, puncture, or otherwise damage the honeycell located at the air inlet end of the MAF/IAT. Do not touch the sensing elements or allow anything including cleaning solvents and lubricants to come in contact with them. Use a small amount of a non-silicone based lubricant, on the air duct only, to aid in installation. 1. Disconnect the MAF/IAT sensor electrical connector. 2. Loosen the clamps at the MAF/IAT sensor and the throttle body. 3. Remove the air cleaner outlet duct bolt. 4. Remove the air cleaner outlet duct. 5. Loosen the clamp attaching the MAF/IAT sensor to the air cleaner housing. 6. Remove the MAF/IAT sensor from the air cleaner housing. Installation Procedure Important: The embossed arrow on the MAF/IAT sensor indicates the proper air flow direction. The arrow must point toward the engine. Page 3191 Refrigerant: Fluid Type Specifications Air Conditioning Refrigerant ....................................................................................................................... R134a P/N 12356150 U.S. (10953485 Canada) Page 8409 2. Locate the nose piece locking tabs that are positioned on the side of the connector nose piece. The connector nose piece acts as a terminal positive assurance (TPA) and may be referred to as such. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to push in one of the locking tabs while gently pulling on the same side of the nose piece. 4. Repeat the procedure for the other locking tab and remove the nose piece. 5. Remove the wire dress cover. The following is a general procedure for wire dress cover removal. Use this procedure as a guide, some dress cover removal procedures may vary. 6. Use fingers to squeeze the 2 locking legs of the cover. Page 8789 Release the tabs that are holding the wiredress cover to the connector body. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the slots on both ends of the connector body. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. J 38125-216 can also be used to remove the nose piece. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by lifting the terminal retaining tabs on the inside of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 1626 3. Use a small flat-bladed tool to gently pry off the dress cover by inserting the tool under the cover opposite the harness side and prying up. 4. Remove the cover. 5. Using a small flat-bladed tool, push on the side of the nose piece retainer while pushing the nose piece forward with your thumb. This will release the terminal position assurance (TPA). 6. Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) into the corresponding terminal release cavity. The release cavities are the 2 center rows of cavities on one half of the connector. Page 6739 11. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 12. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 13. Center the high temperature SCT1 shrink tube over the DuraSeal splice sleeve. 14. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the high temperature heat shrink tubing. 15. Gradually move the heat from the center to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 16. Replace any reflective tape and clips that may have been remove during the repair. Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation REPAIRING DAMAGED WIRE INSULATION Wire Size Conversion Page 2632 2. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully push the terminal position assurance (TPA) towards the face of the connector on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA is fragile and may break if not done carefully. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. 3. Use the J 38125-215 tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Engine - MIL ON P0116/P1400 Set In Very Cold Temps Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - MIL ON P0116/P1400 Set In Very Cold Temps TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 10-06-04-008A Date: January 24, 2011 Subject: Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) Illuminated at Very Cold Ambient Temperatures When Using Engine Coolant Heater, DTC P0116 and/or P1400 Set (Relocate Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor and Engine Coolant Heater Cord) Models: 2006-2007 Buick Rainier 2009 Buick LaCrosse Super, Allure Super (Canada Only) 2006-2010 Cadillac Escalade 2006-2007 Chevrolet Monte Carlo 2006-2009 Chevrolet Impala SS, TrailBlazer 2006-2010 Chevrolet Avalanche, Express, Silverado Tahoe 2006-2009 GMC Envoy 2006-2010 GMC Savana, Sierra, Yukon 2006-2008 Pontiac Grand Prix 2006-2009 Saab 9-7X Equipped with V8 Engine RPO LC9, LH6, LH8, LH9, L76, LS2, LS4, LFA, LZ1, L92, L94, L9H or L20, L96, LMF, LMG, LY2, LY5, LY6 Please Refer to GMVIS Attention: To properly correct this condition, you must follow both of the procedures to relocate the ECT sensor and the engine coolant heater cord. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add cast iron block engine RPOs and to update the Warranty Information coverage period. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 10-06-04-008 (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). Condition Some customers may comment that the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) illuminates after starting the vehicle when they were using the engine coolant heater in very cold ambient temperatures. This usually occurs in a range of -23 to -40°C (-10 to -40°F) or colder. The technician may observe on a scan tool DTC P0116 and/or P1400 set as Current or in History. Cause This condition may be caused by the engine control module (ECM) determining that the ignition OFF time requirement has been met at start-up and interpreting the temperature difference between the engine coolant temperature (ECT) sensor and the intake air temperature (IAT) sensor as being outside of a calibrated range. Correction Important DO NOT replace the ECM for this condition. Relocating the ECT Sensor 1. Turn ON the ignition with the engine OFF. 2. Perform the diagnostic system check - vehicle. Refer to Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle in SI. ‹› If DTC P0116 and/or P1400 are set and the customer WAS using the engine coolant heater, proceed to Step 3. ‹› If DTC P0116 and/or P1400 are set and the customer WAS NOT using the engine coolant heater, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle in SI. 3. Turn OFF the ignition. Warning To avoid being burned, do not remove the radiator cap or surge tank cap while the engine is hot. The cooling system will release scalding fluid and steam Page 1455 Depress the locks that are located on both sides of the wiredress cover and pull the lever over and past the locks. View of the connector when released from the component. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the front of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool push down on one of the locking tabs and pull the cover up until the dress cover releases. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. Page 5724 9. The illustration shows a cutaway view of the connector to aid the technician in releasing the terminal retainer. 10. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Terminal Position Assurance Locks TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Tyco/Amp Connectors (CM 42-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (CM 42-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the connector body and pull the CPA out. The CPA is on the wire harness side of connector. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 3105 Fluid - A/T: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Water Or Coolant Contamination Information INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 08-07-30-035B Date: November 01, 2010 Subject: Information on Water or Ethylene Glycol in Transmission Fluid Models: 2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks with Automatic Transmission Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 08-07-30-035A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle). Water or ethylene glycol in automatic transmission fluid (ATF) is harmful to internal transmission components and will have a negative effect on reliability and durability of these parts. Water or ethylene glycol in ATF will also change the friction of the clutches, frequently resulting in shudder during engagement or gear changes, especially during torque converter clutch engagement. Indications of water in the ATF may include: - ATF blowing out of the transmission vent tube. - ATF may appear cloudy or, in cases of extreme contamination, have the appearance of a strawberry milkshake. - Visible water in the oil pan. - A milky white substance inside the pan area. - Spacer plate gaskets that appear to be glued to the valve body face or case. - Spacer plate gaskets that appear to be swollen or wrinkled in areas where they are not compressed. - Rust on internal transmission iron/steel components. If water in the ATF has been found and the source of the water entry has not been identified, or if a leaking in-radiator transmission oil cooler is suspected (with no evidence of cross-contamination in the coolant recovery reservoir), a simple and quick test kit is available that detects the presence of ethylene glycol in ATF. The "Gly-Tek" test kit, available from the Nelco Company, should be obtained and the ATF tested to make an accurate decision on the need for radiator replacement. This can help to prevent customer comebacks if the in-radiator transmission oil cooler is leaking and reduce repair expenses by avoiding radiator replacement if the cooler is not leaking. These test kits can be obtained from: Nelco Company Test kits can be ordered by phone or through the website listed above. Orders are shipped standard delivery time but can be shipped on a next day delivery basis for an extra charge. One test kit will complete 10 individual fluid sample tests. For vehicles repaired under warranty, the cost of the complete test kit plus shipping charges should be divided by 10 and submitted on the warranty claim as a net item. The transmission should be repaired or replaced based on the normal cost comparison procedure. Important If water or coolant is found in the transmission, the following components MUST be replaced. - Replace all of the rubber-type seals. - Replace all of the composition-faced clutch plates and/or bands. - Replace all of the nylon parts. - Replace the torque converter. - Thoroughly clean and rebuild the transmission, using new gaskets and oil filter. Important The following steps must be completed when repairing or replacing. Flush and flow check the transmission oil cooler using J 45096. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 02-07-30-052F- Automatic Transmission Oil Cooler Flush and Flow Test Essential Tool J 45096 TransFlow. - Thoroughly inspect the engine cooling system and hoses and clean/repair as necessary. Page 7304 2. Connect the MDI to the Data Link Connector (DLC) of the vehicle. Note Use the USB port to make the following MDI connection: 3. Connect the MDI to a PC or laptop that has been downloaded with the GDS application from TIS2WEB. Note At least one Diagnostic Package must be installed on the PC to perform diagnostics. If GDS was just installed, select: Add New Diagnostic Package and then select: a Diagnostic Package to download. 4. Click: On the GDS icon on the PC. 5. The Login Page will appear. 6. Select: A User. 7. The ID Screen will appear. 8. Select: The serial number of the MDI being used. 9. Select: Connect. 10. Verify that the system status is ready by observing for a flashing PC light icon on the MDI. 11. Select: Make, Model and Model Year, in order to build the vehicle. 12. Click: Upload VIN, to allow the VIN to be reported to the PC. 13. At: The Verification step, turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. 14. Select: Next Action. 15. The Home Page will appear. 16. Select: Next. 17. The Diagnostic Screen will appear. Note Due to vehicle build, software and RPO variations, GDS may ask for additional information in Step 18. 18. Select: Engine ID, if prompted. 19. Select: Module Diagnostics. 20. Select: ECM. 21. Select: ID Information. 22. The Diagnostics page will appear. Typical View of GDS Calibration History Screen Note GDS is capable of displaying up to 10 Calibration History events. 23. Select: Calibration History from the drop down menu in order to display the following items on the screen: - Calibration History Buffer - Number of Calibration History Events Stored - Calibration Part Number History - Calibration Verification Number History 24. Select: Screenshot. 25. Name and save the file in an appropriate folder. 26. Select : Print, and retain a copy of the screenshot with the repair order. Page 5300 Release the tabs that are holding the wiredress cover to the connector body. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the slots on both ends of the connector body. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. J 38125-216 can also be used to remove the nose piece. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by lifting the terminal retaining tabs on the inside of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 2168 The engine harness may be repaired using the J-38125. High Temperature Wiring Repairs HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperatures, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time may use materials i.e. wires, connectors, and shielding that has a higher heat rating than typical wiring. When making a repair in a high temperature area observe the following: Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature to replace any damaged wire. - Replace any heat shielding that is removed. - Cover any DuraSeal splice sleeves with SCT1 shrink tubing (available in the J-38125 Terminal Repair kit). - After making a wiring repair, ensure that the location of the wiring is not moved closer to the heat source. IDENTIFYING HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperature, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time need special considerations when making wiring repairs. Areas that may be exposed to higher temperatures can be identified by heat resistant materials that are being used in those areas. These materials may include heat reflective tape, moon tape, and high temperature shrink tubing. Also conduit and other protective coverings may be used. Because conduit or similar coverings are used throughout the vehicle regardless of the temperature, it may be necessary for the technician to determine if an area is exposed to excessive heat before making a wiring repair. Obvious areas of consideration would be any area located near the exhaust manifolds, catalytic converter, and exhaust pipes. The J-38125 contains much of the material you will need to perform repairs on areas exposed to high heat. The kit contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves to crimp and seal connections - High temperature SCT1 shrink tubing to protect the splice sleeves - A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct crimp tool to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools to remove the terminals from the connectors The J-38125 does not contain wire that is suitable to high temperature exposure. Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature of the same or larger gage size as the original wire when repair damage wire. Also replace any reflective tape that you remove during the repair. HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature rating of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125 and then encapsulate the splice sleeve using the high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the order listed. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip keeping all of the wire strands intact. Page 8023 The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors. 1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position. 4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool J 38125-10A (GM P/N 12014012-1) into the front (mating end) of the connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal through the back of the connector (2). IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector. 6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. 7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily. 10. Perform system check. Delphi Connectors (12 Way) DELPHI CONNECTORS (12-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. Page 3478 7. Connect the instrument panel harness connector (1) to the block base. 8. Install the junction block to the block base.Ensure that the retaining tabs are fully seated. 9. Install the 3 bolts (1) that retain the junction block to the block base. Tighten the 3 bolts to 3.5 N.m (31 lb in). 10. Install the BCM to the rear electrical center. 11. Install the battery feed terminal nut (2) to the junction block. Tighten the battery feed terminal nut to 10 N.m (88 lb in). 12. Install the rear electrical center cover. 13. If replacing the rear electrical center on a Chevrolet TrailBlazer or GMC Envoy, position the left second row seat to a passenger position. 14. If replacing the rear electrical center on a Chevrolet TrailBlazer EXT or GMC Envoy XL, install the left second row seat. 15. Connect the battery negative cable. Page 5993 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry one side of the nose piece up to the pre-stage position. When the nose piece is in the pre-staged position, the nose piece will be raised above the connector body the length of the step in the nose piece. 7. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry the other side of the piece to the pre-stage position. If the nose piece is higher than the first step in the nose piece, gently push down on the nose piece until it meets with resistance from the connector body, you should feel the nose piece click into position. Page 3093 Coolant: Technical Service Bulletins Cooling System - Coolant Recycling Information Bulletin No.: 00-06-02-006D Date: August 15, 2006 INFORMATION Subject: Engine Coolant Recycling and Warranty Information Models: 2007 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2007 and Prior HUMMER Vehicles 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X Attention: Please address this bulletin to the Warranty Claims Administrator and the Service Manager. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to adjust the title and Include Warranty Information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 00-06-02-006C (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). Coolant Reimbursement Policy General Motors supports the use of recycled engine coolant for warranty repairs/service, providing a GM approved engine coolant recycling system is used. Recycled coolant will be reimbursed at the GMSPO dealer price for new coolant plus the appropriate mark-up. When coolant replacement is required during a warranty repair, it is crucial that only the relative amount of engine coolant concentrate be charged, not the total diluted volume. In other words: if you are using two gallons of pre-diluted (50:50) recycled engine coolant to service a vehicle, you may request reimbursement for one gallon of GM Goodwrench engine coolant concentrate at the dealer price plus the appropriate warranty parts handling allowance. Licensed Approved DEX-COOL(R) Providers Important: USE OF NON-APPROVED VIRGIN OR RECYCLED DEX-COOL(R) OR DEVIATIONS IN THE FORM OF ALTERNATE CHEMICALS OR ALTERATION OF EQUIPMENT, WILL VOID THE GM ENDORSEMENT, MAY DEGRADE COOLANT SYSTEM INTEGRITY AND PLACE THE COOLING SYSTEM WARRANTY UNDER JEOPARDY. Shown in Table 1 are the only current licensed and approved providers of DEX-COOL(R). Products that are advertised as "COMPATIBLE" or "RECOMMENDED" for use with DEX-COOL(R) have not been tested or approved by General Motors. Non-approved coolants may degrade the Page 6264 Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size. REPAIRING A FUSIBLE LINK IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient overload protection. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. Flat Wire Repairs FLAT WIRE REPAIRS NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced. GMLAN Wiring Repairs GMLAN WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The GM Local Area Network (GMLAN) System requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working on GMLAN connectors and terminals. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items in order to repair the GMLAN wiring: Dura Seal splice sleeves - A wire stripping tool - J 38125-8 Crimping Tool (GM P/N 12085115) - J 38125-5 Ultra Torch Special Tool (GM P/N 12085116) The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. - A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors GMLAN REPAIRS IMPORTANT: When making a repair to any GMLAN network, the original wire length after the repair must be the same length as before the repair. If the network is a twisted pair, the twist must be maintained after the repair is completed. GMLAN has 2 types of networks, low speed and high speed. Low speed GMLAN has a single wire and works at slow speeds. High speed GMLAN has 2 wires in a twisted pair and works at higher speeds. For more information on GMLAN, refer to Data Link Communications Description and Operation. GMLAN CONNECTOR TERMINAL REPAIR IMPORTANT: A service terminal can be used to replace damaged connector terminals for both high speed and low speed GMLAN systems. When making a connector terminal repair on a GMLAN high speed system with twisted pair wires, do not untwist the wires more than necessary to make the repair. The terminals in the GMLAN system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are available in the J-38125. If the individual terminals are damaged on any GMLAN connection, use the appropriate connector repair procedure in order to repair the terminal. GMLAN WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 581 Control Module HVAC: Service and Repair HVAC - Manual Auxiliary Heater and Air Conditioning Control Module Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Using a flat bladed tool, carefully pry out on the top of the HVAC control-auxiliary. 2. Remove the HVAC control-auxiliary from the center console/seat. 3. Disconnect the electrical connector. 4. Remove the rear HVAC control-auxiliary from the vehicle. Installation Procedure 1. Connect the rear HVAC control-auxiliary electrical connector. 2. Install the HVAC control-auxiliary in the console bottom first. 3. Push in at the top of the HVAC control-auxiliary in order to engage the HVAC control-auxiliary in the console/seat. Page 456 Page 1859 11. Insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) into the 2 triangular cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 12. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE 1. Prior to installation the terminal must be aligned so the (1) coding lugs align with the (2) coding grooves on the connector. 2. Once the terminal is aligned, slide the terminal into the cavity until the retainer has engaged in the cavity of the connector. 3. Slide the TPA in the connector body and seat it using a small flat bladed tool. The TPA is seated when it is flush with the contact housing. 4. Secure the wires to the connector body using a tie wrap and replace the dress cover and grommet. Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) BOSCH CONNECTORS (2.8 JPT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Pull out the slider on the connector position assurance (CPA) until it is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Tire Pressure Monitor - TPM System Message/Service Tips Low Tire Pressure Indicator: Technical Service Bulletins Tire Pressure Monitor - TPM System Message/Service Tips # 09-03-16-002A: Dealership Service Consultant Procedure as Vehicle Comes into Service Drive for Tire Pressure Monitor (TPM) System Message, Light and Customer Information - (Apr 27, 2010) Subject: Dealership Service Consultant Procedure as Vehicle Comes into Service Drive for Tire Pressure Monitor (TPM) System Message, Light and Customer Information Models: 2006-2011 Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Including Saturn and Saab) 2006-2010 HUMMER H2, H3 ATTENTION The information found in this bulletin is to be used as a dealership service consultant procedures for customers coming into the service lane with an illuminated "low tire light" or comments on a check tire pressure/low tire pressure/add air to tire or service tire monitor system message. Maintaining proper tire pressures is an Owner's Maintenance item and is not covered under warranty. This bulletin is being revised to add model years and update additional bulletin reference information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 09-03-16-002 (Section 03 -- Suspension). Customer Concerns and Confusion with the Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) System The following procedure should be used by dealership service consultants when a customer comes into the service drive with a "low tire light" on or comments on a check tire pressure/low tire pressure/add air to tire or service tire monitor system message. The service consultant should perform the following steps: Procedure Turn the key to ON, without starting the engine. ^ If the low tire light comes on and stays on solid with a check tire pressure/low tire pressure/add air to tire message (on vehicles equipped with DIC), advise the customer: - The system is working properly. - Properly adjusting all tire air pressures to the recommended levels and driving the vehicle will turn the light off (refer to the Tire and Loading Information label on the driver side door). - More detailed information can be found in the Owner Manual. - Service is not covered under warranty - this maintenance is the responsibility of the owner. - Give the customer a copy of the "GM Customer TPMS Information". ^ If the Tire Pressure Monitor (TPM) light blinks for one minute then stays on solid with a service tire monitor system message (on vehicles equipped with DIC): - A TPM system problem exists. The vehicle should be written up accordingly and sent to your service department for further DTC diagnosis and service. - If dashes (--) are displayed in only one or two of the tire pressure readouts, it is likely caused by a previous TPM system relearn that was performed incorrectly due to interference from another vehicle's TPM system during the relearn process (refer to the Important statement later in this bulletin regarding TPM relearn with a Tech 2(R)). - If dashes (--) are displayed in all four of the tire pressure readouts, there is a system problem. Follow the appropriate SI service procedures. ^ If a customer indicates the low tire light comes on for a few minutes when the vehicle is started, then goes off after driving a while, advise the customer: - The system is working properly. - Most likely, air pressure in one or more of the tires is low enough to turn the light on when tires are cold. After driving for a while, tires will heat Page 5358 View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. View of the release tool being used for the smaller terminals. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (2-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 8534 - Kostel - Molex - Sumitomo - Tyco/AMP - Yazaki Identifying the manufacturer of a connector is often difficult. When trying to determine the manufacturer of a connector, look for specific identifying marks that are unique to that connector supplier. Most of these identify marks are hard to find or see. Check the connector carefully and refer to the information below for pictures and descriptions of connector identification markings. - Most of AFLs connectors have EPC on their connector body. Some of the smaller connectors will not have any markings on them. - In some cases Bosch will actually be printed on the connector. If Bosch does not appear on the connector, look for the Bosch logo. The Bosch logo is a circle with a blunted arrow inside. This logo can appear anywhere on the connector and is often very small. Page 5053 Heat Shield: Service and Repair Exhaust Manifold Heat Shield Replacement - Right Side Exhaust Manifold Heat Shield Replacement - Right Side Removal Procedure 1. Remove the spark plugs. Refer to Spark Plug Replacement for the 5.3L engine or Spark Plug Replacement for the 6.0L engine. 2. Remove the heat shield bolts and the shield from the exhaust manifold. Installation Procedure Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 1. Install the heat shield and the bolts to the exhaust manifold. Tighten the bolts to 9 N.m (80 lb in). 2. Install the spark plugs. Refer to Spark Plug Replacement for the 5.3L engine or Spark Plug Replacement for the 6.0L engine. Page 6695 TERMINAL REMOVAL Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors. 1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA) device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1). 3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 4. Gently pull the cable and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector. 5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal, refer to Terminal Repair. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3. Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector. REINSTALLING TERMINAL 1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly, refer to Wiring Repairs. 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3. Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) DELPHI CONNECTORS (WEATHER PACK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 4402 pulling it through. This will prevent damage to the internal seals of the connector. Once the terminal is pushed out of the connector, cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible and pull the wire through the connector. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE The Micro-Pack 100W connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool was developed to crimp Micro-Pack 100W terminals. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 2. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert the terminal into the crimp tool until the core wings are flush with the anvil on the crimp tool. Be sure that the wings are pointed toward the crimp tool former and release the spring locator. The locator will hold the terminal in place. Inspect the alignment of the terminal wings with the crimp tool former. If the terminal wings are wider than the crimp tool former, remove the terminal and bend the terminal wings in slightly. 5. Place stripped wire into terminal. 6. Crimp the new terminal to the wire. If a jam occurs, press the emergency release to open applicator. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire perform the following procedure in order to replace Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. Heater Inlet Hose Replacement (LH6) Heater Hose: Service and Repair Heater Inlet Hose Replacement (LH6) Heater Inlet Hose Replacement (LH6) Page 5752 6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias. Reference the appropriate service manual wiring schematic to obtain the correct diode installation position. 7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for the soldering equipment. 8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed. 9. IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode attachment points with tape. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape. Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable SPLICING TWISTED OR SHIELDED CABLE Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable. 1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splice is made. 3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire. Staggering the splices by 65 mm (2.5 in) is recommended. 4. IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical contact with the drain wire. Re-assemble the cable. Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape. - Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1). - Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire. - Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape. Page 9015 Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested: - Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. - Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a component or to other harnesses. - If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A TEST LAMP TOOLS REQUIRED J 35616-200 Test Light - Probe Kit NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminate even though voltage is present. The J 35616-200 is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair of leads. To properly operate this tool use the following procedures. When testing for voltage: 1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested. When testing for ground: 1. Attach one lead to battery positive voltage. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where ground should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is ground at the point being tested. Using Connector Test Adapters USING CONNECTOR TEST ADAPTERS NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Using Fused Jumper Wires USING FUSED JUMPER WIRES TOOLS REQUIRED J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged. The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested. AFL/ECP Connectors AFL/EPC CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 5240 6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias. Reference the appropriate service manual wiring schematic to obtain the correct diode installation position. 7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for the soldering equipment. 8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed. 9. IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode attachment points with tape. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape. Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable SPLICING TWISTED OR SHIELDED CABLE Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable. 1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splice is made. 3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire. Staggering the splices by 65 mm (2.5 in) is recommended. 4. IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical contact with the drain wire. Re-assemble the cable. Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape. - Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1). - Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire. - Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape. Page 7176 - Most Molex connectors will have the Molex logo on the dresscover of the connector. In some cases the connectors may have MX followed by another letter. The third letter indicates where the connector was made. A connector with MXD is a Molex connector made in Detroit. Sumitomo has a unique symbol on their connector and possibly a part number. The symbol is similar to that of a diamond lying on its side, similar to that shown. The logo could appear anywhere but the most common place is at the wire side of the housing. Tyco/AMP has many different and unique connector designs. Some may or may not have identifiable marks on them. Page 518 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the rear TPA from the connector. 7. IMPORTANT: The front TPA cannot be removed from the connector. Only move it to the release point. Use a small flat-blade tool to move the front TPA to the release position. 8. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 9. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Molex Connectors Valve Lifter Oil Filter Replacement Lifter / Lash Adjuster: Service and Repair Valve Lifter Oil Filter Replacement Valve Lifter Oil Filter Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Remove the intake manifold. Refer to Intake Manifold Replacement. 2. Disconnect the electrical connector from the oil pressure sensor. Important: Do not allow dirt or debris to enter the passages of the manifold. Plug as required. 3. Remove the oil pressure sensor (1) and washer (2). 4. Remove the oil filter (3). 5. Inspect the O-ring (4) for cuts or damage. If the filter is plugged or the O-ring is cut or damaged, replace the filter and O-ring as an assembly. Installation Procedure Important: Do not allow dirt or debris to enter the passages of the manifold. Plug as required. 1. Install a NEW oil filter (3) and O-ring (4) assembly. 2. Apply sealant to the threads of the sensor. Refer to Sealers, Adhesives, and Lubricants for the correct part number. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 3. Install the oil pressure sensor (1) and washer (2). Tighten the oil pressure sensor to 35 N.m (26 lb ft). Page 6767 Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection Fuel System Diagnosis Fuel System Diagnosis Diagnostic Fault Information Perform the Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle prior to using this diagnostic procedure. Circuit/System Description When the ignition is turned ON, the engine control module (ECM) supplies power to the in-tank fuel pump, by energizing the fuel pump relay. The in-tank fuel pump remains ON as long as the engine is cranking or running and the ECM receives crankshaft reference pulses. If there are no reference pulses, the ECM turns the in-tank fuel pump OFF, 2 seconds after the ignition switch is turned ON or 2 seconds after the engine stops running. The electric fuel pump is incorporated into the modular fuel pump and sender assembly and is located inside the fuel tank. The fuel pump supplies fuel through a fuel filter, also located in the modular fuel pump and sender assembly, through the fuel feed pipes, to the fuel rail assembly. The fuel pump provides fuel at a pressure above the pressure needed by the fuel injectors. The fuel pressure regulator, located in the modular fuel pump and sender assembly, keeps the fuel available to the fuel injectors at a regulated pressure. When the fuel pressure rises above the pressure regulator calibration, the pressure is relieved, with excess fuel exhausted into the modular fuel pump and sender assembly reservoir. Circuit/System Verification Important: * Inspect the fuel system for damage or external leaks before proceeding. * Verify that adequate fuel is in the fuel tank before proceeding. * The fuel pump relay may need to be commanded ON a few times in order to obtain the highest possible fuel pressure. Ignition ON, command the fuel pump relay ON with a scan tool. You should hear the fuel pump turn ON and OFF. ‹› If the fuel pump does not operate, refer to Fuel Pump Electrical Circuit Diagnosis. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics * Ignition OFF, all accessories OFF, install the J34730-1A. Refer to Fuel Pressure Gage Installation and Removal. * Ignition ON, command the fuel pump relay ON with a scan tool. Verify the fuel pressure is between 345-414 kPa (50-60 psi) and remains steady for 5 minutes. Circuit/System Testing Important: * The fuel pump relay may need to be commanded ON a few times in order to obtain the highest possible fuel pressure. * DO NOT start the engine. Ignition ON, command the fuel pump relay ON with a scan tool and observe the fuel pressure gage while the fuel pump is operating. Verify the fuel pressure is between 345-414 kPa (50-60 psi). ‹› If the fuel pressure is greater than the specified range, replace the fuel pump. ‹› If the fuel pressure is less than the specified range, remove the fuel tank and test, inspect, and repair the items listed below. If all items test normal, replace the fuel pump. * Restricted fuel feed pipe * Restricted or plugged fuel filter * Restricted or plugged strainer * Stuck or binding fuel level float * Inspect the harness connectors and the ground circuits of the fuel pump for poor connections. Important: The fuel pressure may vary slightly when the fuel pump stops operating. After the fuel pump stops operating, the fuel pressure should stabilize and remain constant. * Verify that the fuel pressure does not decrease more than 34 kPa (5 psi) in 1 minute. ‹› If the fuel pressure decreases more than the specified value, perform the following procedure: Page 542 breakers are used. CIRCUIT BREAKER This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high current is removed. POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) CIRCUIT BREAKER This type greatly increases its resistance when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker will re-close within a second or 2. Circuit Protection - Fuses CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSES The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and examine the element in the fuse for an open (2). If not broken (1), also check for continuity using a DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one of equal current rating. Circuit Protection - Fusible Links CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSIBLE LINKS Page 210 The first connector design of the Micro-Pack 100W (1) has a white connector interface that holds the terminals. The second design of the Micro-Pack 100W (2) has a gray interface to hold the terminals. Also, the first design has terminal cavities that are further apart (3 mm centerline) and offset from the other row of terminal cavities in the connector. The second design has terminals cavities that are closer together (2.54 mm centerline) and aligned vertically. One other way to identify the second design is the thin strip of material that runs along the outside of the cavities. IMPORTANT: There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W terminals which are very similar. Ensure that you have the correct terminal before crimping the new terminal to the wire. The first design connector uses the longer terminal (1) that has a raised area in front of the recess in the terminal. The second design connector uses the shorter terminal without the raised area. Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro-Pack 100W connectors. Some Micro-Pack 100W connector disassembly procedures will vary. Use this procedure as a guide. 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 5175 - In some cases Delphi will actually be printed on the connector. If Delphi is not printed on the connector, look for PED. In both cases there is no specific orientation for Delphi or PED and they can appear anywhere on the connector. - FCI connectors may have the FCI logo on their connectors. The logo is the letters FCI with an "A" above it. - JAE connector have JAE in small letters on their connectors. Engine - Low Oil Lamp ON/Oil Leaks Oil Pressure Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Low Oil Lamp ON/Oil Leaks TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 07-06-01-004A Date: November 25, 2008 Subject: All Vortec(R) GEN IV V8 Engines - LY2 LS4 LC9 LH6 LMG LY5 LS2 L76 LY6 L92 LS7, Low Oil Level Indicator Lamp On and/or Engine Oil Leak (Reseal Oil Pressure Sensor) Models Supercede: This bulletin is being updated to include a labor operation number for CTS-V and Corvette models. Please discard Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 07-06-01-004 (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System). Condition Some customers may comment on a low oil level indicator lamp on and/or engine oil leak. Upon further investigation, the technician may find that the oil leak is at the oil pressure sensor that is threaded into the valve lifter oil manifold (VLOM) assembly and/or engine valley cover. Correction If the engine oil leak was found to be at the engine oil pressure sensor, then remove the oil pressure sensor and reseal with a pipe sealant with Teflon or equivalent, P/N 12346004 (in Canada, P/N 10953480). Refer to Engine Oil Pressure Sensor and/or Switch Replacement in SI. Parts Information Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models) Page 8812 pulling it through. This will prevent damage to the internal seals of the connector. Once the terminal is pushed out of the connector, cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible and pull the wire through the connector. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE The Micro-Pack 100W connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool was developed to crimp Micro-Pack 100W terminals. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 2. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert the terminal into the crimp tool until the core wings are flush with the anvil on the crimp tool. Be sure that the wings are pointed toward the crimp tool former and release the spring locator. The locator will hold the terminal in place. Inspect the alignment of the terminal wings with the crimp tool former. If the terminal wings are wider than the crimp tool former, remove the terminal and bend the terminal wings in slightly. 5. Place stripped wire into terminal. 6. Crimp the new terminal to the wire. If a jam occurs, press the emergency release to open applicator. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire perform the following procedure in order to replace Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. Page 6708 4. Slide the dress cover forward and off of the connector. 5. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front and rear of the connector. Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON Air Filter Element: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-013B Date: February 01, 2007 INFORMATION Subject: Automatic Transmission Shift, Engine Driveability Concerns or Service Engine Soon (SES) Light On as a Result of the Use of an Excessively/Over-Oiled Aftermarket, Reusable Air Filter Models: 2007 and Prior GM Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2007 and Prior Saturn Models 2003-2007 HUMMER H2 2006-2007 HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 04-07-30-013A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle). The use of an excessively/over-oiled aftermarket, reusable air filter may result in: Service Engine Soon (SES) light on Transmission shift concerns, slipping and damaged clutch(es) or band(s) Engine driveability concerns, poor acceleration from a stop, limited engine RPM range The oil that is used on these air filter elements may be transferred onto the Mass Air Flow (MAF) sensor causing contamination of the sensor. As a result, the Grams per Second (GPS) signal from the MAF may be low and any or all of the concerns listed above may occur. When servicing a vehicle with any of these concerns, be sure to check for the presence of an aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter. The MAF, GPS reading should be compared to a like vehicle with an OEM air box and filter under the same driving conditions to verify the concern. The use of an aftermarket reusable air filter DOES NOT void the vehicle's warranty. If an aftermarket reusable air filter is used, technicians should inspect the MAF sensor element and the air induction hose for contamination of oil prior to making warranty repairs. Transmission or engine driveability concerns (related to the MAF sensor being contaminated with oil) that are the result of the use of an aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter are not considered to be warrantable repair items. Page 1384 6. Gently pry the plastic terminal retainer down and carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (16-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, pull the two connector halves apart. Page 8088 Engine Control Module: Description and Operation Engine Control Module Description The powertrain has electronic controls to reduce exhaust emissions while maintaining excellent driveability and fuel economy. The engine control module (ECM) is the control center of this system. The ECM monitors numerous engine and vehicle functions. The ECM constantly monitors the information from various sensors and other inputs, and controls the systems that affect vehicle performance and emissions. The ECM also performs the diagnostic tests on various parts of the system. The ECM can recognize operational problems and alert the driver via the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL). When the ECM detects a malfunction, the ECM stores a diagnostic trouble code (DTC). The problem area is identified by the particular DTC that is set. The control module supplies a buffered voltage to various sensors and switches. Review the components and wiring diagrams in order to determine which systems are controlled by the ECM. Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) Operation The malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) is located in the instrument panel cluster. The MIL will display as either SERVICE ENGINE SOON or one of the following symbols when commanded ON: The MIL indicates that an emissions related fault has occurred and vehicle service is required. The following is a list of the modes of operation for the MIL: * The MIL illuminates when the ignition is turned ON, with the engine OFF. This is a bulb test to ensure the MIL is able to illuminate. * The MIL turns OFF after the engine is started if a diagnostic fault is not present. * The MIL remains illuminated after the engine is started if the control module detects a fault. A diagnostic trouble code (DTC) is stored any time the control module illuminates the MIL due to an emissions related fault. The MIL turns OFF after three consecutive ignition cycles in which a Test Passed has been reported for the diagnostic test that originally caused the MIL to illuminate. * The MIL flashes if the control module detects a misfire condition which could damage the catalytic converter. * When the MIL is illuminated and the engine stalls, the MIL will remain illuminated as long as the ignition is ON. * When the MIL is not illuminated and the engine stalls, the MIL will not illuminate until the ignition is cycled OFF and then ON. Page 3261 - Yazaki has a wedge or arrow shape, similar to that shown. Delphi Connectors (Micro .64) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro 64 connectors. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. The lever lock may be located on the top or sides of the wire dress cover. Page 8129 It is very important to use the correct test adapter when testing for proper terminal contact of fuses and relays in a bussed electrical center (BEC). Use J-35616-35 to test for proper terminal contact. Failure to use J-35616-35 can result in improper diagnosis of the BEC. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Separate the connector halves. 2. Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body. 3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J-38125 , test that the retention force is significantly different between a good terminal and a suspect terminal. Replace the female terminal in question. FLAT WIRE (DOCK AND LOCK) CONNECTORS There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock) connectors on the harness side or the component side. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Remove the component in question. 2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side of the connector as oil from your skin may be a source of contamination as well. 3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other imperfections that could cause poor terminal contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are uniform and free of damage or deformation. 4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the on the flat wire harness connector in order to test the circuit in question. CONTROL MODULE/COMPONENT VOLTAGE AND GROUNDS Poor voltage or ground connections can cause widely varying symptoms. Test all control module voltage supply circuits. Many vehicles have multiple circuits supplying voltage to a control module. Other components in the system may have separate voltage supply circuits that may also need to be tested. Inspect connections at the module/component connectors, fuses, and any intermediate connections between the voltage source and the module/component. A test lamp or a DMM may indicate that voltage is present, but neither tests the ability of the circuit to carry sufficient current. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Power Distribution Schematics. - Test all control module ground and system ground circuits. The control module may have multiple ground circuits. Other components in the system may have separate grounds that may also need to be tested. Inspect grounds for clean and tight connections at the grounding point. Inspect the connections at the component and in splice packs, where applicable. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Ground Distribution Schematics. TEMPERATURE SENSITIVITY - An intermittent condition may occur when a component/connection reaches normal operating temperature. The condition may occur only when the component/connection is cold, or only when the component/connection is hot. - Freeze Frame, Failure Records, Snapshot, or Vehicle Data Recorder data may help with this type of intermittent condition, where applicable. - If the intermittent is related to heat, review the data for a relationship with the following: High ambient temperatures - Underhood/engine generated heat - Circuit generated heat due to a poor connection, or high electrical load - Higher than normal load conditions, towing, etc. - If the intermittent is related to cold, review the data for the following: Low ambient temperatures-In extremely low temperatures, ice may form in a connection or component. Inspect for water intrusion. - The condition only occurs on a cold start. - The condition goes away when the vehicle warms up. - Information from the customer may help to determine if the trouble follows a pattern that is temperature related. - If temperature is suspected of causing an intermittent fault condition, attempt to duplicate the condition. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required. ELECTROMAGNETIC INTERFERENCE (EMI) AND ELECTRICAL NOISE Some electrical components/circuits are sensitive to electromagnetic interference (EMI) or other types of electrical noise. Inspect for the following conditions: A misrouted harness that is too close to high voltage/high current devices such as secondary ignition components, motors, generator etc-These components may induce electrical noise on a circuit that could interfere with normal circuit operation. - Electrical system interference caused by a malfunctioning relay, or a control module driven solenoid or switch-These conditions can cause a sharp electrical surge. Normally, the condition will occur when the malfunctioning component is operating. - Improper installation of non-factory or aftermarket add on accessories such as lights, 2-way radios, amplifiers, electric motors, remote starters, alarm systems, cell phones, etc-These accessories may lead to interference while in use, but do not fail when the accessories are not in use. - Test for an open diode across the A/C compressor clutch and for other open diodes. Some relays may contain a clamping diode. - The generator may be allowing AC noise into the electrical system. INCORRECT CONTROL MODULE - There are only a few situations where reprogramming a control module is appropriate: A new service control module is installed. Page 7213 7. Pressing the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool in the release cavity of the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and crimper in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (DOOR MODULE) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Side view of connector. View of top of connector. 1. Locate the assist lever and lock on the top of the connector. Locations Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Locations Engine Controls Component Views Fuel Tank 1 - Fuel Tank Pressue (FTP) Sensor 2 - Fuel Pump and Sender Assembly 3 - Chassis Harness 4 Fuel Tank 5 - Evaporative Emission (EVAP) Canister Vent Solenoid Page 6486 View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. 4. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers CIRCUIT PROTECTION - CIRCUIT BREAKERS A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types of circuit Page 761 Open the harness by removing any tape. 2. Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. 3. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 4. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent american wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 5. Slide a section of high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing down the length of wire to be spliced. Ensure that the shrink tubing will not interfere with the splice procedure. 6. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 7. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. 8. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 9. Insert the wire into the DuraSeal splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 10. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Locations Low Pressure Sensor / Switch: Locations HVAC Component Views RR of the Engine Compartment 1 - A/C Low Pressure Switch 2 - Forward Lamp Harness 3 - A/C Accumulator Page 401 4. Use a small flat-blade tool to slide the terminal position assurance (TPA) up one notch on both ends of the connector. The TPA is located underneath the wire dress cover. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 7678 2. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully push the terminal position assurance (TPA) towards the face of the connector on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA is fragile and may break if not done carefully. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. 3. Use the J 38125-215 tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 8687 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Ensure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the Terminal Removal Procedure. Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PULL TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL If the terminal is visibly damaged or is suspected of having a faulty connection, the terminal should be replaced. Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors: 1. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) device and/or the secondary lock. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component or separate the connectors for in-line connectors. 3. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device. 4. Insert the proper pick or removal tool into the front of the connector body. 5. IMPORTANT: On connectors with more than one terminal the service loop may not be large enough to remove the terminal and crimp on a new one. If the terminal wire does not have a large enough service loop for removal, cut the wire 5 cm (2 in) behind the connector before removal. Grasp the wire at the back of the connector body and gently push the terminal out the front of the connector body. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. If the wire needed to be cut in order to remove the terminal, gently push a small length of the same size wire through the back of the connector cavity until there is enough wire exposed in order to crimp on a new terminal. If the wire was not cut, cut the existing wire as close to the old terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 4. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. TERMINAL INSTALLATION 1. Align the terminal and pull the wire from the back of the connector in order to seat the terminal. 2. If necessary, cut the new wire to proper length and splice with existing circuit. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. 3. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply dielectric grease to the connector. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PUSH TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 1259 repairs. 3. Remove the Inflatable Restraint Steering Wheel Module using the procedure found in Service Information. Remove the horn contacts from the steering wheel. Clean the brass contact on the end of the red wires with an abrasive pad. If possible, remove any contamination present on the mating contact on the cancel cam (inside the black tube). Also clean the four copper rivets embedded in the steering wheel frame. Apply GM Dielectric Lubricant to all the contacts to protect against reoccurrence of the corrosion. Refer to the graphic. 4. Reinstall the horn contacts and the Inflatable Restraint Steering Wheel Module and test for proper operation of the horn pad. Test for proper operation of the horn pad through the entire steering wheel rotation. Does the horn pad work properly? ^ Yes - repair is complete. ^ No - proceed with step 5. 5. Is the inoperative condition only present at certain steering wheel positions? ^ Yes - proceed with step 6. ^ No - proceed with step 9. 6. Remove the steering column trim covers. Position the steering wheel on a dead spot. Ground a test light to the steering column frame close to the steering wheel. Probe the surface of the turn signal cancel cam with the test light. Does grounding the cam activate the horn? ^ Yes - this may mean that the contact of the cancel cam that mates to the horn contact wiring harness contact, may not be clean enough or that the cancel cam may need to be replaced. Repair as necessary. Procedure complete. ^ No - proceed with step 7.Turn Signal Cancel Cam: 7. Disconnect the wiring harness that goes to the top of the multi-function switch (connector X1). Using the grounded test light, touch the harness connection for pin G. Does grounding the pin activate the horn? ^ Yes - proceed with step 8. ^ No - try grounding the test light on a known good ground. If this activates the horn, proceed to step 9. If not, investigate a possible condition with the wiring harness or BCM with appropriate SI documents. 8. The condition lies either in the multi-function switch or the interface between the multi-function switch and the cancel cam. In some cases, removing the multi-function switch and clearing the horn contact that mates with the cancel cam (refer to the graphic) of debris and reinstalling the switch will eliminate the condition. In other cases, the cancel cam may be losing contact with the multi-function switch contact. If distortion in the cancel cam is present, it may be necessary to replace the cancel cam. Repair as necessary. Procedure complete. 9. Remove the left side IP insulator (refer to Instrument Panel Insulator Panel Replacement found in SI) so it can be moved aside enough to see the Page 6365 4. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the rear of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. 5. Once the locking tabs are unlocked, slide the inner connector out of the rear of the connector housing. Page 8325 6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias. Reference the appropriate service manual wiring schematic to obtain the correct diode installation position. 7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for the soldering equipment. 8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed. 9. IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode attachment points with tape. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape. Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable SPLICING TWISTED OR SHIELDED CABLE Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable. 1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splice is made. 3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire. Staggering the splices by 65 mm (2.5 in) is recommended. 4. IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical contact with the drain wire. Re-assemble the cable. Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape. - Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1). - Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire. - Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape. Page 9020 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (BSK) BOSCH CONNECTORS (BSK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 3. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 4. Insert the J 38125-561 tool into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 5. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is Page 192 difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Bosch Connectors (ECM) BOSCH CONNECTORS (ECM) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the assist lever on the top of the connector. Move the assist lever to the forward position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 2227 - Most Molex connectors will have the Molex logo on the dresscover of the connector. In some cases the connectors may have MX followed by another letter. The third letter indicates where the connector was made. A connector with MXD is a Molex connector made in Detroit. Sumitomo has a unique symbol on their connector and possibly a part number. The symbol is similar to that of a diamond lying on its side, similar to that shown. The logo could appear anywhere but the most common place is at the wire side of the housing. Tyco/AMP has many different and unique connector designs. Some may or may not have identifiable marks on them. Page 5688 - JST connectors have JST in small letters on their connectors, similar to that above. The location of the logo will vary with the connector size and style. - Kostel has an "LK" with a circle around it. These connector are usually used as a transmissions connection and are currently use on some Cadillac vehicles. Page 2775 16. Install the TCC PWM solenoid (1) to the control valve body. 17. Install the TCC PWM solenoid retainer (2). 18. Connect the internal wiring harness electrical connectors to the following components: ^ The transmission fluid pressure manual valve position switch (1) ^ The 1-2 shift solenoid (2) ^ The 2-3 shift solenoid (3) ^ The pressure control solenoid (4) ^ The TCC PWM solenoid (5) ^ The 3-2 shift solenoid (6) 19. Install the transmission oil pan and filter. Refer to Automatic Transmission Fluid and Filter Replacement. 20. Lower the vehicle. 21. Fill the transmission to the proper level with DEXRON(R) VI transmission fluid. Refer to Transmission Fluid Checking. Important: It is recommended that transmission adaptive pressure (TAP) information be reset. Resetting the TAP values using a scan tool will erase all learned values in all cells. As a result, the engine control module (ECM), powertrain control module (PCM) or transmission control module (TCM) will need to relearn TAP values. Transmission performance may be affected as new TAP values are learned. 22. Reset the TAP values. Refer to Transmission Adaptive Functions (TCM). Page 7845 Oxygen Sensor: Connector Views Engine Controls Connector End Views Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Bank 1 Sensor 1 Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Bank 1 Sensor 2 Page 4953 6. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by pressing on the tang. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (SENSOR) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) tool into the cavity on the lower right hand face of the connector until the terminal release tang access panel slides over. Page 7762 3. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. View showing depressing of the lever lock release tab. Page 4695 Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under the 5 year / 100,000 mile (160,000 km) emission warranty, use: Warranty Information (Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 4612 - Yazaki has a wedge or arrow shape, similar to that shown. Delphi Connectors (Micro .64) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro 64 connectors. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. The lever lock may be located on the top or sides of the wire dress cover. Page 8332 Important: Before installing the camshaft sensor assembly, apply a small amount of clean motor oil to the O-ring (6). 4. Install the camshaft position sensor assembly (4, 5, 6) in the front cover (7). Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 5. Install the camshaft position sensor mounting bolts. Tighten the camshaft position mounting bolts 25 N.m (18 lb ft). 6. Install the generator assembly. Page 4368 MEASURING FREQUENCY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal. IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM to autorange to an appropriate range. 1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency measured. Measuring Voltage MEASURING VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit. 1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods: - Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. - Turn ON the engine. - Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls. - Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested. 3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The DMM displays the voltage measured at that point. Measuring Voltage Drop MEASURING VOLTAGE DROP NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points. Probing Electrical Connectors PROBING ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS Page 8013 View of the connector when released from the component. View of another type of Micro 64 connector. Page 2959 Disclaimer Page 6706 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Kostal Connectors KOSTAL CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 446 5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape. Seat Belt Schematic Icons Seat Belt Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons Page 4072 The dexos (TM) specification and trademarks are exclusive to General Motors, LLC. Only those oils displaying the dexos (TM) trademark and icon on the front label meet the demanding performance requirements and stringent quality standards set forth in the dexos (TM)specification. Look on the front label for any of the logos shown above to identify an authorized, licensed dexos 2(TM) engine oil. GM dexos 2(TM) Engine Oil Specification - dexos 2(TM) is approved and recommended by GM for use in Europe starting in model year 2010 vehicles, regardless of where the vehicle was manufactured. - dexos 2(TM) is the recommended service fill oil for European gasoline engines. Important The Duramax(TM) diesel engine is the exception and requires lubricants meeting specification CJ-4. - dexos 2(TM) is the recommended service fill oil for European light-duty diesel engines and replaces GM-LL-B-025 and GM-LL-A-025. - dexos 2(TM) protects diesel engines from harmful soot deposits and is designed with limits on certain chemical components to prolong catalyst life and protect expensive emission reduction systems. It is a robust oil, resisting degradation between oil changes and maintaining optimum performance longer. Disclaimer Page 3450 Fuse Block - Rear C2 Page 2240 The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors. 1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position. 4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool J 38125-10A (GM P/N 12014012-1) into the front (mating end) of the connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal through the back of the connector (2). IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector. 6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. 7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily. 10. Perform system check. Delphi Connectors (12 Way) DELPHI CONNECTORS (12-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. Page 8768 Page 3360 Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested: - Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. - Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a component or to other harnesses. - If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A TEST LAMP TOOLS REQUIRED J 35616-200 Test Light - Probe Kit NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminate even though voltage is present. The J 35616-200 is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair of leads. To properly operate this tool use the following procedures. When testing for voltage: 1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested. When testing for ground: 1. Attach one lead to battery positive voltage. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where ground should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is ground at the point being tested. Using Connector Test Adapters USING CONNECTOR TEST ADAPTERS NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Using Fused Jumper Wires USING FUSED JUMPER WIRES TOOLS REQUIRED J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged. The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested. AFL/ECP Connectors AFL/EPC CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 3476 Fuse Block: Service and Repair Rear Electrical Center or Junction Block Replacement REAR ELECTRICAL CENTER OR JUNCTION BLOCK REPLACEMENT REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. CAUTION: Refer to Battery Disconnect Caution. Disconnect the battery negative cable. 2. If replacing the rear electrical center on a Chevrolet TrailBlazer EXT or GMC Envoy XL, remove the left second row seat. 3. If replacing the rear electrical center on a Chevrolet TrailBlazer or GMC Envoy, position the left second row seat to a cargo position. 4. Remove the rear electrical center cover. 5. Remove the battery feed terminal nut (2) from the junction block. 6. Remove the body control module (BCM) from the rear electrical center. 7. Fully loosen the 3 bolts (1) that retain the junction block to the electrical connectors. 8. Release the tabs that retain the junction block to the block base. 9. Remove the junction block from the block base. 10. Disconnect the instrument panel harness connector (1) from the junction block. Page 1698 Page 7806 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry one side of the nose piece up to the pre-stage position. When the nose piece is in the pre-staged position, the nose piece will be raised above the connector body the length of the step in the nose piece. 7. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry the other side of the piece to the pre-stage position. If the nose piece is higher than the first step in the nose piece, gently push down on the nose piece until it meets with resistance from the connector body, you should feel the nose piece click into position. Page 865 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Kostal Connectors KOSTAL CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 9062 8. Insert the J 38125-213 into the small terminal release hole on the nose piece and gently pull on the back of the wire. 9. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Repairing Connector Terminals REPAIRING CONNECTOR TERMINALS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following: Push to Seat terminals - Pull to Seat terminals Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your terminal repair. The J-38125 contains further information. 1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.For cable seal terminals, remove the seal. 2. Apply the correct cable seal per gage size of the wire, if used.Slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation removal. 3. Remove the insulation. 4. For sealed terminals only, align the seal with the end of the cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal.For sealed terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal. 6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.For sealed terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable. 8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals excepting Micro-Pack 100.64 size. Soldering Micro-Pack 100 World terminals may damage the terminal. Sumitomo Connectors SUMITOMO CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 8557 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. JST Connectors JST CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, remove the connector from the component. Page 4071 - Support the GM Oil Life System, thereby minimizing the replacement of engine oil, before its life has been depleted. - Reduce the duplication of requirements for a large number of internal GM engine oil specifications. International Lubricants Standardization and Approval Committee (ILSAC) GF-5 Standard In addition to GM dexos 1(TM), a new International Lubricants Standardization and Approval Committee (ILSAC) standard called GF-5, was introduced in October 2010. - There will be a corresponding API category, called: SN Resource Conserving. The current GF-4 standard was put in place in 2004 and will become obsolete in October 2011. Similar to dexos 1(TM), the GF-5 standard will use a new fuel economy test, Sequence VID, which demands a statistically significant increase in fuel economy versus the Sequence VIB test that was used for GF-4. - It is expected that all dexos 1(TM) approved oils will be capable of meeting the GF-5 standard. However, not all GF-5 engine oils will be capable of meeting the dexos 1(TM) specification. - Like dexos(TM), the new ILSAC GF-5 standard will call for more sophisticated additives. The API will begin licensing marketers during October 2010, to produce and distribute GF-5 certified products, which are expected to include SAE 0W-20, 0W-30, 5W-20, 5W-30 and 10W-30 oils. Corporate Average Fuel Economy (CAFE) Requirements Effect on Fuel Economy Since CAFE standards were first introduced in 1974, the fuel economy of cars has more than doubled, while the fuel economy of light trucks has increased by more than 50 percent. Proposed CAFE standards call for a continuation of increased fuel economy in new cars and trucks. To meet these future requirements, all aspects of vehicle operation are being looked at more critically than ever before. New technology being introduced in GM vehicles designed to increase vehicle efficiency and fuel economy include direct injection, cam phasing, turbocharging and active fuel management (AFM). The demands of these new technologies on engine oil also are taken into consideration when determining new oil specifications. AFM for example can help to achieve improved fuel economy. However alternately deactivating and activating the cylinders by not allowing the intake and exhaust valves to open contributes to additional stress on the engine oil. Another industry trend for meeting tough fuel economy mandates has been a shift toward lower viscosity oils. dexos 1(TM) will eventually be offered in several viscosity grades in accordance with engine needs: SAE 0W-20, 5W-20, 0W-30 and 5W-30. Using the right viscosity grade oil is critical for proper engine performance. Always refer to the Maintenance section of a vehicle Owner Manual for the proper viscosity grade for the engine being serviced. GM Oil Life System in Conjunction With dexos (TM) Supports Extended Oil Change Intervals To help conserve oil while maintaining engine protection, many GM vehicles are equipped with the GM Oil Life System. This system can provide oil change intervals that exceed the traditional 3,000 mile (4,830 km) recommendation. The dexos (TM) specification, with its requirements for improved oil robustness, compliments the GM Oil Life System by supporting extended oil change intervals over the lifetime of a vehicle. If all GM customers with GM Oil Life System equipped vehicles would use the system as intended, GM estimates that more than 100 million gallons of oil could be saved annually. GM dexos 2(TM) Information Center Website Refer to the following General Motors website for dexos 2(TM) information about the different licensed brands that are currently available: http://www.gmdexos.com GM dexos 2(TM) Engine Oil Trademark and Icons Page 408 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the rear TPA from the connector. 7. IMPORTANT: The front TPA cannot be removed from the connector. Only move it to the release point. Use a small flat-blade tool to move the front TPA to the release position. 8. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 9. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Molex Connectors Page 1353 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the TPA. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the nose piece. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. Page 283 Memory Seat Module - Driver C2 (w/Memory) Page 7186 pulling it through. This will prevent damage to the internal seals of the connector. Once the terminal is pushed out of the connector, cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible and pull the wire through the connector. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE The Micro-Pack 100W connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool was developed to crimp Micro-Pack 100W terminals. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 2. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert the terminal into the crimp tool until the core wings are flush with the anvil on the crimp tool. Be sure that the wings are pointed toward the crimp tool former and release the spring locator. The locator will hold the terminal in place. Inspect the alignment of the terminal wings with the crimp tool former. If the terminal wings are wider than the crimp tool former, remove the terminal and bend the terminal wings in slightly. 5. Place stripped wire into terminal. 6. Crimp the new terminal to the wire. If a jam occurs, press the emergency release to open applicator. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire perform the following procedure in order to replace Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. Page 2204 IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals. Front probe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the connector. IMPORTANT: When probing female 0.64 terminals, it is important to use the correct adapter. There have been some revisions to the test adapter for 0.64 terminals. The proper adapter for 0.64 terminals is the J 35616-64B which has a gold terminal and a black wire between the base and tip. Failure to use the proper test adapter may result in damage to the terminal being tested and improper diagnosis. NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Page 6325 - JST connectors have JST in small letters on their connectors, similar to that above. The location of the logo will vary with the connector size and style. - Kostel has an "LK" with a circle around it. These connector are usually used as a transmissions connection and are currently use on some Cadillac vehicles. Diagrams Electronic Adjustable Pedals (EAP) Switch Page 5711 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully raise the TPA on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA cannot be removed from the connector while there are terminals present in the connector body. View of the TPA when removed from the connector body. 4. Use the J 38125-12A tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the left side of the terminal release cavity as shown in the graphic. Use the tool to move the terminal release to the right with a gentle prying motion. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 7799 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully raise the TPA on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA cannot be removed from the connector while there are terminals present in the connector body. View of the TPA when removed from the connector body. 4. Use the J 38125-12A tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the left side of the terminal release cavity as shown in the graphic. Use the tool to move the terminal release to the right with a gentle prying motion. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 6527 IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals. Front probe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the connector. IMPORTANT: When probing female 0.64 terminals, it is important to use the correct adapter. There have been some revisions to the test adapter for 0.64 terminals. The proper adapter for 0.64 terminals is the J 35616-64B which has a gold terminal and a black wire between the base and tip. Failure to use the proper test adapter may result in damage to the terminal being tested and improper diagnosis. NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Page 5554 Depress the locks that are located on both sides of the wiredress cover and pull the lever over and past the locks. View of the connector when released from the component. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the front of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool push down on one of the locking tabs and pull the cover up until the dress cover releases. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. Page 2848 Alignment: Description and Operation Camber Description Camber Description Camber Description Camber is the tilting of the wheels from the vertical when viewed from the front of the vehicle. When the wheels tilt outward at the top, the camber is positive (+). When the wheel tilts inward at the top, the camber is negative (-). The amount of tilt is measured in degrees from the vertical. Camber settings influence the directional control and the tire wear. Too much positive camber will result in premature wear on the outside of the tire and cause excessive wear on the suspension parts. Too much negative camber will result in premature wear on the inside of the tire and cause excessive wear on the suspension parts. Unequal side-to-side camber of 1 degree or more will cause the vehicle to pull or lead to the side with the most positive camber. Crankshaft Position Sensor Replacement Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Crankshaft Position Sensor Replacement Crankshaft Position Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure Important: Perform Crankshaft Position System Variation Learn whenever the crankshaft position (CKP) sensor is removed or replaced. 1. Remove the starter. 2. Disconnect the electrical connector (2) from the CKP sensor (1). 3. Clean the area around the CKP sensor before removal in order to avoid debris from entering the engine. 4. Remove the CKP sensor bolt. 5. Remove the CKP sensor. Installation Procedure Specifications Compression Check: Specifications Compression Check Start with the compression gage at zero and crank the engine through 4 compression strokes, 4 puffs. Measure the compression for each cylinder. Record the readings. If a cylinder has low compression, inject approximately 15 ml (1 tablespoon) of engine oil into the combustion chamber through the spark plug hole. Measure the compression again and record the reading. The minimum compression in any 1 cylinder should not be less than 70 percent of the highest cylinder. No cylinder should read less than 690 kPa (100 psi). For example, if the highest pressure in any 1 cylinder is 1,035 kPa (150 psi), the lowest allowable pressure for any other cylinder would be 725 kPa (105 psi). (1 035 x 70% = 725) (150 x 70% = 105). Page 417 9. The illustration shows a cutaway view of the connector to aid the technician in releasing the terminal retainer. 10. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Terminal Position Assurance Locks TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Tyco/Amp Connectors (CM 42-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (CM 42-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the connector body and pull the CPA out. The CPA is on the wire harness side of connector. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 8843 3. Ensure that the terminal release tang access panel is in the correct location to access the terminals. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) into the terminal release tang access slot located behind the access panel of the connector and press down on the terminal while carefully pulling the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Tyco/AMP Connectors (0.25 Cap) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (025 CAP) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component by pressing down on the connector position assurance (CPA). Page 5251 Engine Control Module (ECM) C3 (Pin 1 To 15) Page 5082 Body Control Module: Service and Repair Liftgate Control Module Replacement LIFTGATE CONTROL MODULE REPLACEMENT REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Remove the liftgate trim panel. 2. Disconnect the electrical connectors (3) from the module as necessary. 3. Remove the bolts that retain the module to the liftgate. 4. Remove the module from the liftgate. INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 1. Install the module to the liftgate. 2. NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice. Install the bolts that retain the module to the liftgate. Tighten the bolts to 10 N.m (89 lb in). 3. Connect the electrical connectors (3) as necessary. 4. Install the liftgate trim panel. 5. Program the liftgate control module. Refer to Control Module References. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Page 6266 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Start in the middle and gradually move the heat barrel to the open ends of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Heated Oxygen Sensor Wiring Repairs HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being obstructed. If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. - Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks, etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire. - Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance. - To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector. Page 4632 2. Locate the two indents of the terminal position assurance (TPA) located on the bottom of the connector body. Page 6006 2. Use a small flat-bladed tool to release the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting the tool in the small recess on the side of the connector and pushing up until the TPA releases from the connector body. The TPA should raise just slightly. Do not try to remove the TPA. IMPORTANT: The TPA on this connector cannot be removed unless the terminals are removed first. The TPA will come out of the connector body, but only slightly. When the TPA is slightly raised the terminals can be removed. Using excessive force to remove the TPA with the terminals still in the connector will damage the connector. 3. Repeat the process for the other side of the connector. 4. Ensure that the TPA is in the proper position to remove the terminals. Page 3993 Step 1 - Step 6 Page 7127 7. Wrap electrical tape around the connection as shown. 8. Route the engine coolant heater cord and extension cord behind the alternator and adjacent to the engine coolant crossover pipe as shown. 9. Continue to route the extension cord to the exit location desired by the customer as shown. 10. Review the routing of the coolant heater cord and extension cord to verify that it does not touch any sharp edges that could damage it. 11. Secure the engine coolant heater cord and the extension cord with tie straps as needed. 12. Resecure any of the original clips that retained the engine coolant heater cord to the vehicle that were released to provide length. Part Information The extension cord may be obtained at any of the following outlets: - Lowes* - Home Depot* - Canada: Acklands-Grainger* (www.acklandsgrainger.com), Catalogue Part Number: CWRSJTOW3C14-10 USA: Cords should bear the UL symbol. Canada: Cords should bear the ULc symbol or CSA approval. *We believe these sources and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume any responsibility for the products or material from these firms or for any such items that may be available from other sources. Page 3179 6. Lower the vehicle. 7. Fill the crankcase with the proper quantity and grade of engine oil. Refer to Approximate Fluid Capacities and to Fluid and Lubricant Recommendations. 8. Remove the oil level indicator. 9. Wipe the indicator with a clean cloth. 10. Install the oil level indicator. 11. Remove the oil level indicator in order to check the level. 12. Add oil if necessary. 13. Close the hood. Page 4942 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry one side of the nose piece up to the pre-stage position. When the nose piece is in the pre-staged position, the nose piece will be raised above the connector body the length of the step in the nose piece. 7. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry the other side of the piece to the pre-stage position. If the nose piece is higher than the first step in the nose piece, gently push down on the nose piece until it meets with resistance from the connector body, you should feel the nose piece click into position. Page 6362 3. Use a small flat-bladed tool to gently pry off the dress cover by inserting the tool under the cover opposite the harness side and prying up. 4. Remove the cover. 5. Using a small flat-bladed tool, push on the side of the nose piece retainer while pushing the nose piece forward with your thumb. This will release the terminal position assurance (TPA). 6. Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) into the corresponding terminal release cavity. The release cavities are the 2 center rows of cavities on one half of the connector. Page 5519 Utility/Van Zoning UTILITY/VAN ZONING Page 8847 View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. View of the release tool being used for the smaller terminals. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (2-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON Air Filter Element: Customer Interest Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-013B Date: February 01, 2007 INFORMATION Subject: Automatic Transmission Shift, Engine Driveability Concerns or Service Engine Soon (SES) Light On as a Result of the Use of an Excessively/Over-Oiled Aftermarket, Reusable Air Filter Models: 2007 and Prior GM Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2007 and Prior Saturn Models 2003-2007 HUMMER H2 2006-2007 HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 04-07-30-013A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle). The use of an excessively/over-oiled aftermarket, reusable air filter may result in: Service Engine Soon (SES) light on Transmission shift concerns, slipping and damaged clutch(es) or band(s) Engine driveability concerns, poor acceleration from a stop, limited engine RPM range The oil that is used on these air filter elements may be transferred onto the Mass Air Flow (MAF) sensor causing contamination of the sensor. As a result, the Grams per Second (GPS) signal from the MAF may be low and any or all of the concerns listed above may occur. When servicing a vehicle with any of these concerns, be sure to check for the presence of an aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter. The MAF, GPS reading should be compared to a like vehicle with an OEM air box and filter under the same driving conditions to verify the concern. The use of an aftermarket reusable air filter DOES NOT void the vehicle's warranty. If an aftermarket reusable air filter is used, technicians should inspect the MAF sensor element and the air induction hose for contamination of oil prior to making warranty repairs. Transmission or engine driveability concerns (related to the MAF sensor being contaminated with oil) that are the result of the use of an aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter are not considered to be warrantable repair items. Drive Belt Replacement - Accessory Drive Belt: Service and Repair Drive Belt Replacement - Accessory Drive Belt Replacement - Accessory Removal Procedure 1. Remove the air cleaner resonator outlet duct. Refer to Air Cleaner Resonator Outlet Duct Replacement. 2. Install a breaker bar with hex-head socket to the drive belt tensioner bolt. 3. Rotate the drive belt tensioner clockwise in order to relieve tension on the belt. 4. Remove the belt from the generator pulley. 5. Slowly release the tension on the drive belt tensioner. 6. Remove the breaker bar and socket and from the drive belt tensioner bolt. 7. Remove the belt from the remaining pulleys. 8. Clean and inspect the belt surfaces of all the pulleys. Installation Procedure Page 5934 All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system. Page 3365 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (BSK) BOSCH CONNECTORS (BSK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 3. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 4. Insert the J 38125-561 tool into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 5. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is Page 5766 1. Install the fuel level sensor (2) and electrical connector (1) to the fuel sender assembly. 2. Connect the fuel level sensor electrical connector (1). 3. Ensure the fuel level sensor retaining tabs (2) are fully engaged. 4. Install the fuel sender assembly. Page 5826 - Yazaki has a wedge or arrow shape, similar to that shown. Delphi Connectors (Micro .64) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro 64 connectors. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. The lever lock may be located on the top or sides of the wire dress cover. Page 383 - Yazaki has a wedge or arrow shape, similar to that shown. Delphi Connectors (Micro .64) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro 64 connectors. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. The lever lock may be located on the top or sides of the wire dress cover. Page 773 Page 2821 Windshield Wiper/Washer Switch Page 3574 Refer to the appropriate section of SI for specifications and repair procedures that are related to the vibration concern. Disclaimer Page 519 MOLEX CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. 2. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. Page 2550 Page 1310 Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Page 4642 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 481 difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Bosch Connectors (ECM) BOSCH CONNECTORS (ECM) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the assist lever on the top of the connector. Move the assist lever to the forward position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 1986 5. Insert the J 38125-557 (GM P/N 12122378) into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 6. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Connector Position Assurance Locks CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of the connector. CPAs are used in various connectors throughout the vehicle. CPAs are also used in all SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals, of the connector. Connector Repairs CONNECTOR REPAIRS Page 4593 - A control module from another vehicle is installed. - Revised software/calibration files have been released for this vehicle. - IMPORTANT: DO NOT re-program the control module with the SAME software/calibration files that are already present in the control module. This is not an effective repair for any type of concern. Verify that the control module contains the correct software/calibration. If incorrect programming is found, reprogram the control module with the most current software/calibration. Refer to Control Module References for replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Testing for Short to Ground TESTING FOR SHORT TO GROUND NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 4. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit. With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is a short to ground in the circuit. Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2. Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). - When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. - If the DMM does not display voltage 4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is shorted. Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A DIGITAL MULTIMETER NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the powertrain control module (PCM), should only be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200 Digital Multimeter (DMM). The J 39200 instruction manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminage even though voltage is present. The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity. IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading. Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the measurement. Page 6187 Checking Aftermarket Accessories CHECKING AFTERMARKET ACCESSORIES Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits: - CAUTION: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol. - NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice. OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol. Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the cause of the problems. Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include: Power feeds connected to points other than the battery - Antenna location - Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring - Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line - Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories. Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions INDUCING INTERMITTENT FAULT CONDITIONS TOOLS REQUIRED J 25070 Heat Gun Many intermittent open or shorted circuits are affected by harness/connector movement that is caused by vibration, engine torque, bumps/rough pavement, etc. In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness if the malfunction appears to be Page 2319 It is very important to use the correct test adapter when testing for proper terminal contact of fuses and relays in a bussed electrical center (BEC). Use J-35616-35 to test for proper terminal contact. Failure to use J-35616-35 can result in improper diagnosis of the BEC. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Separate the connector halves. 2. Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body. 3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J-38125 , test that the retention force is significantly different between a good terminal and a suspect terminal. Replace the female terminal in question. FLAT WIRE (DOCK AND LOCK) CONNECTORS There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock) connectors on the harness side or the component side. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Remove the component in question. 2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side of the connector as oil from your skin may be a source of contamination as well. 3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other imperfections that could cause poor terminal contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are uniform and free of damage or deformation. 4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the on the flat wire harness connector in order to test the circuit in question. CONTROL MODULE/COMPONENT VOLTAGE AND GROUNDS Poor voltage or ground connections can cause widely varying symptoms. Test all control module voltage supply circuits. Many vehicles have multiple circuits supplying voltage to a control module. Other components in the system may have separate voltage supply circuits that may also need to be tested. Inspect connections at the module/component connectors, fuses, and any intermediate connections between the voltage source and the module/component. A test lamp or a DMM may indicate that voltage is present, but neither tests the ability of the circuit to carry sufficient current. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Power Distribution Schematics. - Test all control module ground and system ground circuits. The control module may have multiple ground circuits. Other components in the system may have separate grounds that may also need to be tested. Inspect grounds for clean and tight connections at the grounding point. Inspect the connections at the component and in splice packs, where applicable. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Ground Distribution Schematics. TEMPERATURE SENSITIVITY - An intermittent condition may occur when a component/connection reaches normal operating temperature. The condition may occur only when the component/connection is cold, or only when the component/connection is hot. - Freeze Frame, Failure Records, Snapshot, or Vehicle Data Recorder data may help with this type of intermittent condition, where applicable. - If the intermittent is related to heat, review the data for a relationship with the following: High ambient temperatures - Underhood/engine generated heat - Circuit generated heat due to a poor connection, or high electrical load - Higher than normal load conditions, towing, etc. - If the intermittent is related to cold, review the data for the following: Low ambient temperatures-In extremely low temperatures, ice may form in a connection or component. Inspect for water intrusion. - The condition only occurs on a cold start. - The condition goes away when the vehicle warms up. - Information from the customer may help to determine if the trouble follows a pattern that is temperature related. - If temperature is suspected of causing an intermittent fault condition, attempt to duplicate the condition. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required. ELECTROMAGNETIC INTERFERENCE (EMI) AND ELECTRICAL NOISE Some electrical components/circuits are sensitive to electromagnetic interference (EMI) or other types of electrical noise. Inspect for the following conditions: A misrouted harness that is too close to high voltage/high current devices such as secondary ignition components, motors, generator etc-These components may induce electrical noise on a circuit that could interfere with normal circuit operation. - Electrical system interference caused by a malfunctioning relay, or a control module driven solenoid or switch-These conditions can cause a sharp electrical surge. Normally, the condition will occur when the malfunctioning component is operating. - Improper installation of non-factory or aftermarket add on accessories such as lights, 2-way radios, amplifiers, electric motors, remote starters, alarm systems, cell phones, etc-These accessories may lead to interference while in use, but do not fail when the accessories are not in use. - Test for an open diode across the A/C compressor clutch and for other open diodes. Some relays may contain a clamping diode. - The generator may be allowing AC noise into the electrical system. INCORRECT CONTROL MODULE - There are only a few situations where reprogramming a control module is appropriate: A new service control module is installed. Page 8192 Release the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the blue locking tabs on both ends of the connector. Gently slide the TPA up to the released position on both ends. 6. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-13A (GM P/N 12031876-1) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. Page 903 11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the solder equipment. 12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. 13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to cover the first piece of tape. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE SLEEVES TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit IMPORTANT: Use only dura seal splice sleeves. Other splice sleeves may not protect the splice from moisture or provide a good electrical connection. Use duraseal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. Use duraseal splice sleeves where there is special requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire using duraseal splice sleeves. Page 3316 11. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 12. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 13. Center the high temperature SCT1 shrink tube over the DuraSeal splice sleeve. 14. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the high temperature heat shrink tubing. 15. Gradually move the heat from the center to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 16. Replace any reflective tape and clips that may have been remove during the repair. Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation REPAIRING DAMAGED WIRE INSULATION Wire Size Conversion Specifications Connecting Rod Bearing: Specifications Connecting Rod Connecting Rod Bearing Clearance Production ........................................................................................................................................................... 0.023-0.065 mm (0.0009-0.0025 in) Service ....................................................................................... ........................................................................... 0.023-0.076 mm (0.0009-0.003 in) Page 1603 The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors. 1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position. 4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool J 38125-10A (GM P/N 12014012-1) into the front (mating end) of the connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal through the back of the connector (2). IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector. 6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. 7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily. 10. Perform system check. Delphi Connectors (12 Way) DELPHI CONNECTORS (12-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. Page 2447 Connector Anatomy Connector Repairs contains a list of all connector repairs. The connector repairs are listed by the connector manufacturer and then by connector type. If the technician cannot identify the manufacturer of the connector, refer to Identifying Connectors below. Knowing the connector manufacturer will assist in finding the correct connector repair from the following list: - Connector Position Assurance Locks - Terminal Position Assurance Locks - Bosch Connectors (0.64) Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) Bosch Connectors (BSK) Bosch Connectors (ECM) - Delphi Connectors (Micro.64) Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) Delphi Connectors (12-Way) - Tyco/AMP Connectors (CM 42-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) Tyco/AMP Connectors (025 Cap) Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) - Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) - Repairing Connector Terminals IDENTIFYING CONNECTORS Knowing the connector manufacturer is helpful when trying to locating the correct connector repair procedure. There are many different connector designs used on GM vehicles and it is sometimes difficult to identify the connector manufacturer. The information in this document should help with the identification of connector manufactures. The following connector manufacturers make most of the connectors found in GM vehicles: AFL/EPC (Alcoa Fujikura Ltd./Engineered Plastics Components) - Bosch - Delphi - FCI (Framatome Connectors International) - JAE (Japan Aviation Electronics) - JST (Japan Solderless Terminals) Page 8097 Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Testing and Inspection Powertrain Relay Diagnosis Diagnostic Instructions * Perform the Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle prior to using this diagnostic procedure. * Strategy Based Diagnosis for an overview of the diagnostic approach. * Diagnostic Procedure Instructions provide an overview of each diagnostic category. Typical Scan Tool Data Circuit/System Description The powertrain relay is a normally open relay. The relay armature is held in the open position by spring tension. Battery positive voltage is supplied directly to the relay coil and the armature contact at all times. The engine control module (ECM) supplies the ground path to the relay coil control circuit via an internal integrated circuit called an output driver module (ODM). The ODM output control is configured to operate as a low side driver for the powertrain relay. The ODM for the powertrain relay also incorporates a fault detection circuit, which is continuously monitored by the ECM. When the ECM commands the powertrain relay ON, ignition 1 voltage is supplied to the ECM, and to several additional circuits. Diagnostic Aids This test procedure requires that the vehicle battery has passed a load test and is completely charged. Refer to Battery Inspection/Test. See: Starting and Charging/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics/Battery Inspection/Test Circuit/System Verification Important: On the scan tool, the powertrain relay is referred to as the EC ignition relay. 1. Ignition ON, engine OFF, command the powertrain relay ON and OFF several times using the scan tool output control function. You should either hear or feel the relay click with each command. 2. Ignition ON, engine OFF, with a test lamp, probe both test points of all the fuses that are powered by the powertrain relay. The test lamp should illuminate on at least one test point of each fuse. ‹› If the vehicle passes the Circuit/System Verification test, then operate the vehicle within the Conditions for Running the DTC. You may also operate the vehicle within the conditions that are captured in the Freeze Frame/Failure Records Data list. Circuit/System Testing 1. Ignition OFF, disconnect the powertrain relay. 2. Ignition ON, verify that a test lamp does not illuminate between the relay coil control circuit and ground. ‹› If the test lamp illuminates, test the relay coil control circuit for a short to voltage. If the circuit tests normal, replace the ECM. 3. Verify that a test lamp does not illuminate between the relay ignition 1 voltage circuit and ground. ‹› If the test lamp illuminates, test the relay ignition 1 voltage circuit for a short to voltage. If the circuit tests normal, replace the ECM. 4. Verify that a test lamp illuminates between the relay coil B+ and ground. ‹› If the test lamp does not illuminate, test the relay coil B+ circuit for a short to ground or an open/high resistance. 5. Verify that a test lamp illuminates between the relay switch B+ and ground. ‹› If the test lamp does not illuminate, test the relay switch B+ circuit for a short to ground or an open/high resistance. If the circuits test normal and the fuse for the ignition 1 voltage circuit is open, test the ignition 1 voltage circuit to the ECM for a short to ground. If the circuit tests Specifications Idle Speed: Specifications Information not supplied by Manufacturer. Page 8741 US English/Metric Conversion US English/Metric Conversion Page 539 6. Gently pry the plastic terminal retainer down and carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (16-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, pull the two connector halves apart. Page 7286 3. Connect the MDI to a PC or laptop that has been downloaded with the GDS application from TIS2WEB. Note At least one Diagnostic Package must be installed on the PC to perform diagnostics. If GDS was just installed, select: Add New Diagnostic Package and then select: a Diagnostic Package to download. 4. Click: On the GDS icon on the PC. 5. The Login Page will appear. 6. Select: A User. 7. The ID Screen will appear. 8. Select: The serial number of the MDI being used. 9. Select: Connect. 10. Verify that the system status is ready by observing for a flashing PC light icon on the MDI. 11. Select: Make, Model and Model Year, in order to build the vehicle. 12. Click: Upload VIN, to allow the VIN to be reported to the PC. 13. At: The Verification step, turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. 14. Select: Next Action. 15. The Home Page will appear. 16. Select: Next. 17. The Diagnostic Screen will appear. Note Due to vehicle build, software and RPO variations, GDS may ask for additional information in Step 18. 18. Select: Engine ID, if prompted. 19. Select: Module Diagnostics. 20. Select: ECM. 21. Select: ID Information. 22. The Diagnostics page will appear. Typical View of GDS Calibration History Screen Note GDS is capable of displaying up to 10 Calibration History events. 23. Select: Calibration History from the drop down menu in order to display the following items on the screen: - Calibration History Buffer - Number of Calibration History Events Stored - Calibration Part Number History - Calibration Verification Number History 24. Select: Screenshot. 25. Name and save the file in an appropriate folder. 26. Select : Print, and retain a copy of the screenshot with the repair order. 27. E-mail a copy of the screenshot to [email protected]. In the subject line of the e-mail include the phrase "V8 Cal" as well as the complete VIN and Dealer BAC. In the body of the e-mail, include the VIN, mileage, R.O. number and BAC. Include a brief description of the customer concern and cause of the concern. Page 4488 Release the tabs that are holding the wiredress cover to the connector body. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the slots on both ends of the connector body. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. J 38125-216 can also be used to remove the nose piece. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by lifting the terminal retaining tabs on the inside of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 1483 3. Remove the dress cover by using a flat-blade tool to release the connector locking tabs and pulling off the dress cover. 4. Relieve the tension on the nose piece retainers by inserting J-38125-12A (12094429) into the single retainer slot on the end of the nose piece and gently prying out the locking tab. Repeat the process for both of the nose piece locking tabs on the opposite side of the nose piece. Locations Overhead Console Page 3314 The engine harness may be repaired using the J-38125. High Temperature Wiring Repairs HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperatures, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time may use materials i.e. wires, connectors, and shielding that has a higher heat rating than typical wiring. When making a repair in a high temperature area observe the following: Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature to replace any damaged wire. - Replace any heat shielding that is removed. - Cover any DuraSeal splice sleeves with SCT1 shrink tubing (available in the J-38125 Terminal Repair kit). - After making a wiring repair, ensure that the location of the wiring is not moved closer to the heat source. IDENTIFYING HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperature, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time need special considerations when making wiring repairs. Areas that may be exposed to higher temperatures can be identified by heat resistant materials that are being used in those areas. These materials may include heat reflective tape, moon tape, and high temperature shrink tubing. Also conduit and other protective coverings may be used. Because conduit or similar coverings are used throughout the vehicle regardless of the temperature, it may be necessary for the technician to determine if an area is exposed to excessive heat before making a wiring repair. Obvious areas of consideration would be any area located near the exhaust manifolds, catalytic converter, and exhaust pipes. The J-38125 contains much of the material you will need to perform repairs on areas exposed to high heat. The kit contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves to crimp and seal connections - High temperature SCT1 shrink tubing to protect the splice sleeves - A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct crimp tool to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools to remove the terminals from the connectors The J-38125 does not contain wire that is suitable to high temperature exposure. Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature of the same or larger gage size as the original wire when repair damage wire. Also replace any reflective tape that you remove during the repair. HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature rating of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125 and then encapsulate the splice sleeve using the high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the order listed. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip keeping all of the wire strands intact. Page 7139 Diagram Information and Instructions Throttle Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions Electrical Symbols Page 3113 11. Grasp firmly while pulling down with a twisting motion in order to remove the filter. 12. Remove the filter seal. The filter seal may be stuck in the pump. If necessary, carefully use pliers or another suitable tool to remove the seal. 13. Discard the seal. 14. Inspect the fluid color. 15. Inspect the filter. Pry the metal crimping away from the top of the filter and pull apart. The filter may contain the following evidence for root cause diagnosis: ^ Clutch material ^ Bronze slivers indicating bushing wear ^ Steel particles 16. Clean the transmission case and the oil pan gasket surfaces with solvent, and air dry. You must remove all traces of the old gasket material. Installation Procedure 1. Coat the new filter seal with automatic transmission fluid. 2. Install the new filter seal into the transmission case. Tap the seal into place using a suitable size socket. 3. Install the new filter into the case. Page 5230 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Start in the middle and gradually move the heat barrel to the open ends of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Heated Oxygen Sensor Wiring Repairs HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being obstructed. If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. - Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks, etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire. - Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance. - To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector. Page 4423 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 1777 Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size. REPAIRING A FUSIBLE LINK IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient overload protection. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. Flat Wire Repairs FLAT WIRE REPAIRS NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced. GMLAN Wiring Repairs GMLAN WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The GM Local Area Network (GMLAN) System requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working on GMLAN connectors and terminals. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items in order to repair the GMLAN wiring: Dura Seal splice sleeves - A wire stripping tool - J 38125-8 Crimping Tool (GM P/N 12085115) - J 38125-5 Ultra Torch Special Tool (GM P/N 12085116) The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. - A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors GMLAN REPAIRS IMPORTANT: When making a repair to any GMLAN network, the original wire length after the repair must be the same length as before the repair. If the network is a twisted pair, the twist must be maintained after the repair is completed. GMLAN has 2 types of networks, low speed and high speed. Low speed GMLAN has a single wire and works at slow speeds. High speed GMLAN has 2 wires in a twisted pair and works at higher speeds. For more information on GMLAN, refer to Data Link Communications Description and Operation. GMLAN CONNECTOR TERMINAL REPAIR IMPORTANT: A service terminal can be used to replace damaged connector terminals for both high speed and low speed GMLAN systems. When making a connector terminal repair on a GMLAN high speed system with twisted pair wires, do not untwist the wires more than necessary to make the repair. The terminals in the GMLAN system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are available in the J-38125. If the individual terminals are damaged on any GMLAN connection, use the appropriate connector repair procedure in order to repair the terminal. GMLAN WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 6905 4. Once the front 2 locks are unlocked, lift the front of the dress cover and pull it forward. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the small slot on the TPA and pushing down until the TPA releases. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to angle or rock the J 38125-21 tool when inserting it into the connector or the tool may break. Insert the J 38125-21 (GM P/N 15381651-2) tool into the round canal between the terminals cavities at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to repair Micro 64 connector terminals. The Micro 64 connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-64 (M jaw) was developed to crimp Micro 64 terminals. The J 38125-64 crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. The J 38125-64 crimping tool is also designed to crimp both the wire and the insulation at the same time. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro 64 terminals. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. 1. Cut the wire as close to the damaged terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. Page 5447 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Ensure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the Terminal Removal Procedure. Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PULL TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL If the terminal is visibly damaged or is suspected of having a faulty connection, the terminal should be replaced. Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors: 1. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) device and/or the secondary lock. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component or separate the connectors for in-line connectors. 3. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device. 4. Insert the proper pick or removal tool into the front of the connector body. 5. IMPORTANT: On connectors with more than one terminal the service loop may not be large enough to remove the terminal and crimp on a new one. If the terminal wire does not have a large enough service loop for removal, cut the wire 5 cm (2 in) behind the connector before removal. Grasp the wire at the back of the connector body and gently push the terminal out the front of the connector body. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. If the wire needed to be cut in order to remove the terminal, gently push a small length of the same size wire through the back of the connector cavity until there is enough wire exposed in order to crimp on a new terminal. If the wire was not cut, cut the existing wire as close to the old terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 4. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. TERMINAL INSTALLATION 1. Align the terminal and pull the wire from the back of the connector in order to seat the terminal. 2. If necessary, cut the new wire to proper length and splice with existing circuit. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. 3. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply dielectric grease to the connector. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PUSH TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 9024 IMPORTANT: Ensure that the dress cover and connector body are both in the released position before reassembling. Failure to do so may cause damage to the connector and component. Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (0.64) BOSCH CONNECTORS (0.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While pressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock until the lever is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Pull the rubber boot that covers the wires back to expose the end of the connector dress cover. 4. Place the connector locking lever in the center of the connector. 5. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs that are on the wire end of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover and connector body and pry up. Page 1294 Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Install the 3 APP sensor bolts (1). Tighten the bolts to 20 N.m (15 lb ft). 3. Connect the APP sensor electrical connector. 4. Verify that the vehicle meets the following conditions: * The vehicle is not in a reduced engine power mode. * The ignition is ON. * The engine is OFF. 5. Connect a scan tool in order to test for a proper throttle-opening and throttle-closing range. 6. Operate the accelerator pedal and monitor the throttle angles. The accelerator pedal should operate freely, without binding, between a closed throttle, and a wide open throttle. Page 1218 Outside Temperature Display Sensor: Diagrams Displays and Gages Connector End Views Ambient Air Temperature Sensor (DF5) Page 4431 4. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the rear of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. 5. Once the locking tabs are unlocked, slide the inner connector out of the rear of the connector housing. Page 3726 Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. For connectors with a bolt in the dress cover, turn the bolt counterclockwise to remove the connector from the component. 2. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. Page 4564 6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias. Reference the appropriate service manual wiring schematic to obtain the correct diode installation position. 7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for the soldering equipment. 8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed. 9. IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode attachment points with tape. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape. Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable SPLICING TWISTED OR SHIELDED CABLE Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable. 1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splice is made. 3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire. Staggering the splices by 65 mm (2.5 in) is recommended. 4. IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical contact with the drain wire. Re-assemble the cable. Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape. - Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1). - Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire. - Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape. Page 4975 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches, and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original. - The wires insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the possibility of fuel contact. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1). 5. Select the proper duraseal splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool. Refer to the Crimp and Seal Splice Table. 6. Place the duraseal splice sleeve in the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115) crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 7. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to hold the duraseal splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 8. Insert the wires into the duraseal splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel in order to prevent the wire from passing through the splice (3). 9. Close the handles of the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115), until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is applied to the splice sleeve. 10. Shrink the insulation around the splice. - Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. - Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Splicing Inline Harness Diodes SPLICING INLINE HARNESS DIODES Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure. 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode. 2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool. 5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode. Page 8084 Engine Control Module (ECM) C3 (Pin 1 To 15) TPMS System - Service And Re-Learning Sensor IDs Tire Pressure Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins TPMS System - Service And Re-Learning Sensor IDs INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 10-03-16-001 Date: July 19, 2010 Subject: TPMS System Service and Re-Learning Sensor IDs Models: 2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2 2009 and Prior HUMMER H3 2010 and Prior Saturn Models 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X with Wheel-Mounted Tire Pressure Sensors In the event that the spare tire, which is normally not equipped with a tire pressure monitor (TPM) sensor, is installed in place of one of the road tires and the vehicle is driven above 40 km/h (25 mph) for 20 minutes or more, the TPM indicator icon on the instrument panel cluster (IPC) will flash for approximately one minute and then remain on steady each time the ignition is turned ON, indicating a diagnostic trouble code (DTC) has been set. The driver information center (DIC), if equipped, will also display a SERVICE TIRE MONITOR type message. When the road tire is repaired and reinstalled in the original location, the TPM indicator icon illumination and DIC message may remain displayed until the DTC is cleared. To ensure that the TPM indicator and the DIC message are cleared after service, it is necessary to clear any TPM DTCs using a scan tool. If a scan tool is unavailable, performing the TPM relearn procedure using a TPM diagnostic tool will provide the same results. It is advised to perform the relearn procedure away from other vehicles to prevent picking up a stray sensor signal. If one or more of the TPM sensors are missing or damaged and have been replaced, then the relearn procedure must be performed. Disclaimer Page 3312 If a wire is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm, etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except coaxial. - Do not use the DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent American wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 4901 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (BSK) BOSCH CONNECTORS (BSK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 3. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 4. Insert the J 38125-561 tool into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 5. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is Page 6944 Release the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the blue locking tabs on both ends of the connector. Gently slide the TPA up to the released position on both ends. 6. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-13A (GM P/N 12031876-1) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. Page 4899 View of connector in released position. 4. Disconnect the connector from the component. 5. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Release the rear lower half of the wiredress cover. Page 7230 The engine harness may be repaired using the J-38125. High Temperature Wiring Repairs HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperatures, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time may use materials i.e. wires, connectors, and shielding that has a higher heat rating than typical wiring. When making a repair in a high temperature area observe the following: Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature to replace any damaged wire. - Replace any heat shielding that is removed. - Cover any DuraSeal splice sleeves with SCT1 shrink tubing (available in the J-38125 Terminal Repair kit). - After making a wiring repair, ensure that the location of the wiring is not moved closer to the heat source. IDENTIFYING HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperature, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time need special considerations when making wiring repairs. Areas that may be exposed to higher temperatures can be identified by heat resistant materials that are being used in those areas. These materials may include heat reflective tape, moon tape, and high temperature shrink tubing. Also conduit and other protective coverings may be used. Because conduit or similar coverings are used throughout the vehicle regardless of the temperature, it may be necessary for the technician to determine if an area is exposed to excessive heat before making a wiring repair. Obvious areas of consideration would be any area located near the exhaust manifolds, catalytic converter, and exhaust pipes. The J-38125 contains much of the material you will need to perform repairs on areas exposed to high heat. The kit contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves to crimp and seal connections - High temperature SCT1 shrink tubing to protect the splice sleeves - A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct crimp tool to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools to remove the terminals from the connectors The J-38125 does not contain wire that is suitable to high temperature exposure. Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature of the same or larger gage size as the original wire when repair damage wire. Also replace any reflective tape that you remove during the repair. HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature rating of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125 and then encapsulate the splice sleeve using the high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the order listed. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip keeping all of the wire strands intact. Page 7409 11. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 12. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 13. Center the high temperature SCT1 shrink tube over the DuraSeal splice sleeve. 14. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the high temperature heat shrink tubing. 15. Gradually move the heat from the center to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 16. Replace any reflective tape and clips that may have been remove during the repair. Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation REPAIRING DAMAGED WIRE INSULATION Wire Size Conversion Page 1399 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches, and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original. - The wires insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the possibility of fuel contact. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1). 5. Select the proper duraseal splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool. Refer to the Crimp and Seal Splice Table. 6. Place the duraseal splice sleeve in the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115) crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 7. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to hold the duraseal splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 8. Insert the wires into the duraseal splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel in order to prevent the wire from passing through the splice (3). 9. Close the handles of the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115), until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is applied to the splice sleeve. 10. Shrink the insulation around the splice. - Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. - Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Splicing Inline Harness Diodes SPLICING INLINE HARNESS DIODES Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure. 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode. 2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool. 5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode. Page 4415 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Kostal Connectors KOSTAL CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 3462 Fuse Block - Underhood C2 Page 6921 2. Locate the two indents of the terminal position assurance (TPA) located on the bottom of the connector body. Page 5372 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the DuraSeal splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of a connector. CPAs are used in all SIR System connectors and also in some connectors of other systems. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals of a connection. TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE CLIPS IMPORTANT: When making a splice in an area that may be exposed to moisture use a crimp and seal splice sleeve instead of a Splice Clip. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. Page 8853 Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size. REPAIRING A FUSIBLE LINK IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient overload protection. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. Flat Wire Repairs FLAT WIRE REPAIRS NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced. GMLAN Wiring Repairs GMLAN WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The GM Local Area Network (GMLAN) System requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working on GMLAN connectors and terminals. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items in order to repair the GMLAN wiring: Dura Seal splice sleeves - A wire stripping tool - J 38125-8 Crimping Tool (GM P/N 12085115) - J 38125-5 Ultra Torch Special Tool (GM P/N 12085116) The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. - A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors GMLAN REPAIRS IMPORTANT: When making a repair to any GMLAN network, the original wire length after the repair must be the same length as before the repair. If the network is a twisted pair, the twist must be maintained after the repair is completed. GMLAN has 2 types of networks, low speed and high speed. Low speed GMLAN has a single wire and works at slow speeds. High speed GMLAN has 2 wires in a twisted pair and works at higher speeds. For more information on GMLAN, refer to Data Link Communications Description and Operation. GMLAN CONNECTOR TERMINAL REPAIR IMPORTANT: A service terminal can be used to replace damaged connector terminals for both high speed and low speed GMLAN systems. When making a connector terminal repair on a GMLAN high speed system with twisted pair wires, do not untwist the wires more than necessary to make the repair. The terminals in the GMLAN system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are available in the J-38125. If the individual terminals are damaged on any GMLAN connection, use the appropriate connector repair procedure in order to repair the terminal. GMLAN WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 7145 Utility/Van Zoning UTILITY/VAN ZONING Page 7634 Depress the locks that are located on both sides of the wiredress cover and pull the lever over and past the locks. View of the connector when released from the component. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the front of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool push down on one of the locking tabs and pull the cover up until the dress cover releases. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. Page 7606 MEASURING FREQUENCY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal. IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM to autorange to an appropriate range. 1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency measured. Measuring Voltage MEASURING VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit. 1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods: - Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. - Turn ON the engine. - Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls. - Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested. 3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The DMM displays the voltage measured at that point. Measuring Voltage Drop MEASURING VOLTAGE DROP NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points. Probing Electrical Connectors PROBING ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS Page 6606 11. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 12. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 13. Center the high temperature SCT1 shrink tube over the DuraSeal splice sleeve. 14. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the high temperature heat shrink tubing. 15. Gradually move the heat from the center to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 16. Replace any reflective tape and clips that may have been remove during the repair. Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation REPAIRING DAMAGED WIRE INSULATION Wire Size Conversion Page 4438 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert a small flat-blade tool in the slot below the front loaded terminal position assurance (TPA) and pry up. 3. Remove the TPA by pulling it out of the connector. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-553 (GM P/N 15315247) on a slight upward angle into the cavity below the terminal to be removed. Ensure that the pointed on the end of the tool is facing the bottom of the terminal and it stays in contact with the terminal until it stops on the plastic terminal retainer. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 7184 2. Locate the nose piece locking tabs that are positioned on the side of the connector nose piece. The connector nose piece acts as a terminal positive assurance (TPA) and may be referred to as such. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to push in one of the locking tabs while gently pulling on the same side of the nose piece. 4. Repeat the procedure for the other locking tab and remove the nose piece. 5. Remove the wire dress cover. The following is a general procedure for wire dress cover removal. Use this procedure as a guide, some dress cover removal procedures may vary. 6. Use fingers to squeeze the 2 locking legs of the cover. Page 6520 All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system. Page 5846 2. Locate the two indents of the terminal position assurance (TPA) located on the bottom of the connector body. Page 7547 View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. 4. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers CIRCUIT PROTECTION - CIRCUIT BREAKERS A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types of circuit Page 6407 All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system. Page 1856 5. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove TPA from the connector. 6. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Page 7708 normal, replace the ECM. 6. Connect a test lamp between the relay coil B+ and the relay coil control circuit. 7. Ignition ON, command the powertrain relay ON and OFF with a scan tool. The test lamp should turn ON and OFF when changing between the commanded states. ‹› If the test lamp is always ON, test the relay coil control circuit for a short to ground. If the circuit tests normal, replace the ECM. ‹› If the test lamp is always OFF, test the relay coil control circuit for a short to voltage or an open/high resistance. If the circuit tests normal, replace the ECM. 8. Connect a 20A fused jumper wire between the relay switch B+ and the relay ignition 1 voltage circuit. 9. Ignition ON, engine OFF, monitor the EC Ignition Relay Feedback parameter with a scan tool. The parameter should display B+. ‹› If the parameter does not display B+, test the ignition 1 voltage circuit for an open/high resistance. If the circuit tests normal, replace the ECM. 10. If all circuits test normal, test or replace the relay. Component Testing 1. Ignition OFF, disconnect the powertrain relay. 2. Test for 65-110 ohms of resistance between terminals 85 and 86 of the relay. ‹› If the resistance is not within the specified range, replace the relay. 3. Test for infinite resistance between following terminals: * Terminal 30 and 86 * Terminal 30 and 87 * Terminal 30 and 85 * Terminal 85 and 87 ‹› If not the specified value, replace the relay. 4. Install a 20A fused jumper wire between relay terminal 85 and 12 volts. Install a jumper wire between relay terminal 86 and ground. Test for less than 1 ohm of resistance between terminals 30 and 87. ‹› If greater than the specified range, replace the relay. Repair Instructions Perform the Diagnostic Repair Verification after completing the diagnostic procedure. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests and Procedures * Relay Replacement (Attached to Wire Harness) Relay Replacement (Within an Electrical Center) * Underhood Electrical Center or Junction Block Replacement * Control Module References for ECM replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Page 4553 If a wire is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm, etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except coaxial. - Do not use the DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent American wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 8017 The first connector design of the Micro-Pack 100W (1) has a white connector interface that holds the terminals. The second design of the Micro-Pack 100W (2) has a gray interface to hold the terminals. Also, the first design has terminal cavities that are further apart (3 mm centerline) and offset from the other row of terminal cavities in the connector. The second design has terminals cavities that are closer together (2.54 mm centerline) and aligned vertically. One other way to identify the second design is the thin strip of material that runs along the outside of the cavities. IMPORTANT: There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W terminals which are very similar. Ensure that you have the correct terminal before crimping the new terminal to the wire. The first design connector uses the longer terminal (1) that has a raised area in front of the recess in the terminal. The second design connector uses the shorter terminal without the raised area. Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro-Pack 100W connectors. Some Micro-Pack 100W connector disassembly procedures will vary. Use this procedure as a guide. 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 2171 If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs SIR/SRS WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS, and the wiring components, such as connectors and terminals. IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system terminals. Use either an SIR/SRS pigtail or a terminated lead from the SIR Repair Kit Tray. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves, in order to repair the SIR/SRS wiring - A special crimping tool - A heat torch - An instruction manual The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides the necessary low resistance contact integrity for these sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors SIR/SRS CONNECTOR REPAIR (PLASTIC BODY AND TERMINAL METAL PIN) The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made with a special plating. This plating provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. Use the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit for repairing SIR/SRS terminals and connectors. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the repair kit. The J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit contains: Various terminated leads for sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) terminal replacement - Various connector positive assurance (CPA) locks for SIR/SRS connectors - Base of steering column pigtail connectors part number 12085514 - Yellow vinyl electrical tape Pigtail repair packs are available for SIR/SRS connectors with eight or less terminals. Only the connector body is available for connectors with more than eight terminals. The terminated leads in the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit can be used to replace damaged terminals when replacing the connector body. SIR/SRS COMPONENT WIRE PIGTAIL REPAIR IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails. A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device, not by a connector. If a wiring pigtail is damaged, you must replace the entire component, with pigtail. The inflatable restraint steering wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component. SIR/SRS WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 907 US English/Metric Conversion US English/Metric Conversion Page 4318 14. Install the air cleaner outlet duct and bolt. Tighten the bolt to 10 N.m (89 lb in). 15. Tighten the air cleaner outlet duct clamps at the following locations: ^ Throttle body ^ MAF/IAT sensor Tighten the clamps to 7 N.m (62 lb in). 16. Fill the cooling system. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System (LL8) Draining and Filling Cooling System (LH6, LS2). Page 6151 11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the solder equipment. 12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. 13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to cover the first piece of tape. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE SLEEVES TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit IMPORTANT: Use only dura seal splice sleeves. Other splice sleeves may not protect the splice from moisture or provide a good electrical connection. Use duraseal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. Use duraseal splice sleeves where there is special requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire using duraseal splice sleeves. Page 6184 Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids Arrows and Symbols Arrows and Symbols This Service Data uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations. Arrows and Symbols 1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow Basic Knowledge Required GENERAL ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures contained in the service manual. You should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current (amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram, as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. Decimal and Metric Equivalents Decimal and Metric Equivalents Page 1979 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (BSK) BOSCH CONNECTORS (BSK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 3. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 4. Insert the J 38125-561 tool into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 5. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is Page 5790 Page 4815 TERMINAL REMOVAL Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors. 1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA) device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1). 3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 4. Gently pull the cable and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector. 5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal, refer to Terminal Repair. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3. Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector. REINSTALLING TERMINAL 1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly, refer to Wiring Repairs. 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3. Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) DELPHI CONNECTORS (WEATHER PACK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 5517 Page 213 pulling it through. This will prevent damage to the internal seals of the connector. Once the terminal is pushed out of the connector, cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible and pull the wire through the connector. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE The Micro-Pack 100W connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool was developed to crimp Micro-Pack 100W terminals. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 2. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert the terminal into the crimp tool until the core wings are flush with the anvil on the crimp tool. Be sure that the wings are pointed toward the crimp tool former and release the spring locator. The locator will hold the terminal in place. Inspect the alignment of the terminal wings with the crimp tool former. If the terminal wings are wider than the crimp tool former, remove the terminal and bend the terminal wings in slightly. 5. Place stripped wire into terminal. 6. Crimp the new terminal to the wire. If a jam occurs, press the emergency release to open applicator. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire perform the following procedure in order to replace Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. Page 2619 9. The illustration shows a cutaway view of the connector to aid the technician in releasing the terminal retainer. 10. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Terminal Position Assurance Locks TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Tyco/Amp Connectors (CM 42-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (CM 42-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the connector body and pull the CPA out. The CPA is on the wire harness side of connector. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 7017 If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200 DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J 39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected. IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J 39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and maximum (MAX) values measured. 1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of a suspected circuit to the other. 2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J 39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep). IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value in order to record the full change. 5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling the connections or the wiring, test driving, or performing other operations. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions. 6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9. Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist. Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections TESTING FOR INTERMITTENT CONDITIONS AND POOR CONNECTIONS TOOLS REQUIRED - J 35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit - J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit When the condition is not currently present, but is indicated in DTC history, the cause may be intermittent. An intermittent may also be the cause when there is a customer complaint, but the symptom cannot be duplicated. Refer to the Symptom Table of the system that is suspect of causing the condition before trying to locate an intermittent condition. Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the following items: Wiring broken inside the insulation - Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector - Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself, and corrosion in the wire to terminal contact area, etc. - Pierced or damaged insulation can allow moisture to enter the wiring causing corrosion. The conductor can corrode inside the insulation, with little visible evidence. Look for swollen and stiff sections of wire in the suspect circuits. - Wiring which has been pinched, cut, or its insulation rubbed through may cause an intermittent open or short as the bare area touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle. - Wiring that comes in contact with hot or exhaust components - Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required, in order to verify the customer concern. - Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. - Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis and Vehicle Data Recorder operation. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any inline connectors before replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation. Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination, usually in the underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit. Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper adapter. Always use the J 35616 when probing connectors. Other causes of terminal deformation are improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT IN BUSSED ELECTRICAL CENTERS (BEC) Page 700 11. Insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) into the 2 triangular cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 12. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE 1. Prior to installation the terminal must be aligned so the (1) coding lugs align with the (2) coding grooves on the connector. 2. Once the terminal is aligned, slide the terminal into the cavity until the retainer has engaged in the cavity of the connector. 3. Slide the TPA in the connector body and seat it using a small flat bladed tool. The TPA is seated when it is flush with the contact housing. 4. Secure the wires to the connector body using a tie wrap and replace the dress cover and grommet. Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) BOSCH CONNECTORS (2.8 JPT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Pull out the slider on the connector position assurance (CPA) until it is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 8657 It is very important to use the correct test adapter when testing for proper terminal contact of fuses and relays in a bussed electrical center (BEC). Use J-35616-35 to test for proper terminal contact. Failure to use J-35616-35 can result in improper diagnosis of the BEC. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Separate the connector halves. 2. Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body. 3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J-38125 , test that the retention force is significantly different between a good terminal and a suspect terminal. Replace the female terminal in question. FLAT WIRE (DOCK AND LOCK) CONNECTORS There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock) connectors on the harness side or the component side. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Remove the component in question. 2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side of the connector as oil from your skin may be a source of contamination as well. 3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other imperfections that could cause poor terminal contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are uniform and free of damage or deformation. 4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the on the flat wire harness connector in order to test the circuit in question. CONTROL MODULE/COMPONENT VOLTAGE AND GROUNDS Poor voltage or ground connections can cause widely varying symptoms. Test all control module voltage supply circuits. Many vehicles have multiple circuits supplying voltage to a control module. Other components in the system may have separate voltage supply circuits that may also need to be tested. Inspect connections at the module/component connectors, fuses, and any intermediate connections between the voltage source and the module/component. A test lamp or a DMM may indicate that voltage is present, but neither tests the ability of the circuit to carry sufficient current. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Power Distribution Schematics. - Test all control module ground and system ground circuits. The control module may have multiple ground circuits. Other components in the system may have separate grounds that may also need to be tested. Inspect grounds for clean and tight connections at the grounding point. Inspect the connections at the component and in splice packs, where applicable. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Ground Distribution Schematics. TEMPERATURE SENSITIVITY - An intermittent condition may occur when a component/connection reaches normal operating temperature. The condition may occur only when the component/connection is cold, or only when the component/connection is hot. - Freeze Frame, Failure Records, Snapshot, or Vehicle Data Recorder data may help with this type of intermittent condition, where applicable. - If the intermittent is related to heat, review the data for a relationship with the following: High ambient temperatures - Underhood/engine generated heat - Circuit generated heat due to a poor connection, or high electrical load - Higher than normal load conditions, towing, etc. - If the intermittent is related to cold, review the data for the following: Low ambient temperatures-In extremely low temperatures, ice may form in a connection or component. Inspect for water intrusion. - The condition only occurs on a cold start. - The condition goes away when the vehicle warms up. - Information from the customer may help to determine if the trouble follows a pattern that is temperature related. - If temperature is suspected of causing an intermittent fault condition, attempt to duplicate the condition. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required. ELECTROMAGNETIC INTERFERENCE (EMI) AND ELECTRICAL NOISE Some electrical components/circuits are sensitive to electromagnetic interference (EMI) or other types of electrical noise. Inspect for the following conditions: A misrouted harness that is too close to high voltage/high current devices such as secondary ignition components, motors, generator etc-These components may induce electrical noise on a circuit that could interfere with normal circuit operation. - Electrical system interference caused by a malfunctioning relay, or a control module driven solenoid or switch-These conditions can cause a sharp electrical surge. Normally, the condition will occur when the malfunctioning component is operating. - Improper installation of non-factory or aftermarket add on accessories such as lights, 2-way radios, amplifiers, electric motors, remote starters, alarm systems, cell phones, etc-These accessories may lead to interference while in use, but do not fail when the accessories are not in use. - Test for an open diode across the A/C compressor clutch and for other open diodes. Some relays may contain a clamping diode. - The generator may be allowing AC noise into the electrical system. INCORRECT CONTROL MODULE - There are only a few situations where reprogramming a control module is appropriate: A new service control module is installed. Page 5342 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry one side of the nose piece up to the pre-stage position. When the nose piece is in the pre-staged position, the nose piece will be raised above the connector body the length of the step in the nose piece. 7. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry the other side of the piece to the pre-stage position. If the nose piece is higher than the first step in the nose piece, gently push down on the nose piece until it meets with resistance from the connector body, you should feel the nose piece click into position. Page 3380 View of the connector when released from the component. View of another type of Micro 64 connector. Page 375 6. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs located on the opposite side of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover at the connector end and pry up. 7. Remove the dress cover. 8. Cut the tie wrap on the wire bundle. 9. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting a small flat-bladed tool into the small slot in the end of the slider and pushing on the TPA until it comes out of the connector. When the TPA exits the opposite side of the connector, gasp the TPA and pull it completely out of the connector. 10. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 1793 Page 8233 Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids Arrows and Symbols Arrows and Symbols This Service Data uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations. Arrows and Symbols 1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow Basic Knowledge Required GENERAL ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures contained in the service manual. You should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current (amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram, as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. Decimal and Metric Equivalents Decimal and Metric Equivalents Page 4823 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. JST Connectors JST CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, remove the connector from the component. Page 5452 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the TPA. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the nose piece. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. Page 5110 3. Connect the MDI to a PC or laptop that has been downloaded with the GDS application from TIS2WEB. Note At least one Diagnostic Package must be installed on the PC to perform diagnostics. If GDS was just installed, select: Add New Diagnostic Package and then select: a Diagnostic Package to download. 4. Click: On the GDS icon on the PC. 5. The Login Page will appear. 6. Select: A User. 7. The ID Screen will appear. 8. Select: The serial number of the MDI being used. 9. Select: Connect. 10. Verify that the system status is ready by observing for a flashing PC light icon on the MDI. 11. Select: Make, Model and Model Year, in order to build the vehicle. 12. Click: Upload VIN, to allow the VIN to be reported to the PC. 13. At: The Verification step, turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. 14. Select: Next Action. 15. The Home Page will appear. 16. Select: Next. 17. The Diagnostic Screen will appear. Note Due to vehicle build, software and RPO variations, GDS may ask for additional information in Step 18. 18. Select: Engine ID, if prompted. 19. Select: Module Diagnostics. 20. Select: ECM. 21. Select: ID Information. 22. The Diagnostics page will appear. Typical View of GDS Calibration History Screen Note GDS is capable of displaying up to 10 Calibration History events. 23. Select: Calibration History from the drop down menu in order to display the following items on the screen: - Calibration History Buffer - Number of Calibration History Events Stored - Calibration Part Number History - Calibration Verification Number History 24. Select: Screenshot. 25. Name and save the file in an appropriate folder. 26. Select : Print, and retain a copy of the screenshot with the repair order. 27. E-mail a copy of the screenshot to [email protected]. In the subject line of the e-mail include the phrase "V8 Cal" as well as the complete VIN and Dealer BAC. In the body of the e-mail, include the VIN, mileage, R.O. number and BAC. Include a brief description of the customer concern and cause of the concern. Page 7153 IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals. Front probe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the connector. IMPORTANT: When probing female 0.64 terminals, it is important to use the correct adapter. There have been some revisions to the test adapter for 0.64 terminals. The proper adapter for 0.64 terminals is the J 35616-64B which has a gold terminal and a black wire between the base and tip. Failure to use the proper test adapter may result in damage to the terminal being tested and improper diagnosis. NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Page 3241 It is very important to use the correct test adapter when testing for proper terminal contact of fuses and relays in a bussed electrical center (BEC). Use J-35616-35 to test for proper terminal contact. Failure to use J-35616-35 can result in improper diagnosis of the BEC. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Separate the connector halves. 2. Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body. 3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J-38125 , test that the retention force is significantly different between a good terminal and a suspect terminal. Replace the female terminal in question. FLAT WIRE (DOCK AND LOCK) CONNECTORS There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock) connectors on the harness side or the component side. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Remove the component in question. 2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side of the connector as oil from your skin may be a source of contamination as well. 3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other imperfections that could cause poor terminal contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are uniform and free of damage or deformation. 4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the on the flat wire harness connector in order to test the circuit in question. CONTROL MODULE/COMPONENT VOLTAGE AND GROUNDS Poor voltage or ground connections can cause widely varying symptoms. Test all control module voltage supply circuits. Many vehicles have multiple circuits supplying voltage to a control module. Other components in the system may have separate voltage supply circuits that may also need to be tested. Inspect connections at the module/component connectors, fuses, and any intermediate connections between the voltage source and the module/component. A test lamp or a DMM may indicate that voltage is present, but neither tests the ability of the circuit to carry sufficient current. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Power Distribution Schematics. - Test all control module ground and system ground circuits. The control module may have multiple ground circuits. Other components in the system may have separate grounds that may also need to be tested. Inspect grounds for clean and tight connections at the grounding point. Inspect the connections at the component and in splice packs, where applicable. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Ground Distribution Schematics. TEMPERATURE SENSITIVITY - An intermittent condition may occur when a component/connection reaches normal operating temperature. The condition may occur only when the component/connection is cold, or only when the component/connection is hot. - Freeze Frame, Failure Records, Snapshot, or Vehicle Data Recorder data may help with this type of intermittent condition, where applicable. - If the intermittent is related to heat, review the data for a relationship with the following: High ambient temperatures - Underhood/engine generated heat - Circuit generated heat due to a poor connection, or high electrical load - Higher than normal load conditions, towing, etc. - If the intermittent is related to cold, review the data for the following: Low ambient temperatures-In extremely low temperatures, ice may form in a connection or component. Inspect for water intrusion. - The condition only occurs on a cold start. - The condition goes away when the vehicle warms up. - Information from the customer may help to determine if the trouble follows a pattern that is temperature related. - If temperature is suspected of causing an intermittent fault condition, attempt to duplicate the condition. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required. ELECTROMAGNETIC INTERFERENCE (EMI) AND ELECTRICAL NOISE Some electrical components/circuits are sensitive to electromagnetic interference (EMI) or other types of electrical noise. Inspect for the following conditions: A misrouted harness that is too close to high voltage/high current devices such as secondary ignition components, motors, generator etc-These components may induce electrical noise on a circuit that could interfere with normal circuit operation. - Electrical system interference caused by a malfunctioning relay, or a control module driven solenoid or switch-These conditions can cause a sharp electrical surge. Normally, the condition will occur when the malfunctioning component is operating. - Improper installation of non-factory or aftermarket add on accessories such as lights, 2-way radios, amplifiers, electric motors, remote starters, alarm systems, cell phones, etc-These accessories may lead to interference while in use, but do not fail when the accessories are not in use. - Test for an open diode across the A/C compressor clutch and for other open diodes. Some relays may contain a clamping diode. - The generator may be allowing AC noise into the electrical system. INCORRECT CONTROL MODULE - There are only a few situations where reprogramming a control module is appropriate: A new service control module is installed. Specifications Engine Oil Pressure: Specifications Oil Pressure - Minimum - Hot .................................................................................................................................................. 41 kPa at 1,000 engine RPM (6 psig at 1,000 engine RPM) .............................................................................................................................................. 124 kPa at 2,000 engine RPM (18 psig at 2,000 engine RPM) .............................................................................................................................................. 165 kPa at 4,000 engine RPM (24 psig at 4,000 engine RPM) Active Fuel Management Relief Valve Oil Pressure - as Measured at Oil Pressure Sensor Location ........................... 379-517 kPa Maximum (55-75 psig Maximum) Page 3111 7. If the fluid level is low, add only enough fluid to bring the level into the HOT band. It does not take much fluid, generally less than one pint (0.5L). Do not overfill. Also, if the fluid level is low, inspect the transmission for leaks. Refer to Fluid Leak Diagnosis. 8. If the fluid level is in the acceptable range, push the dipstick back into the dipstick tube all the way, and then flip the handle down to lock the dipstick in place. 9. If applicable and if the vehicle is equipped, reset the transmission oil life monitor only if the fluid was changed. Fluid Condition Inspection Inspect the fluid color. The fluid should be red or dark brown. ^ If the fluid color is very dark or black and has a burnt odor, inspect the fluid and inside of the bottom pan for excessive metal particles or other debris. A small amount of "friction"; material in the bottom pan is a "normal"; condition. If large pieces and/or metal particles are noted in the fluid or bottom pan, flush the oil cooler and cooler lines and overhaul the transmission. If there are no signs of transmission internal damage noted, replace the fluid filter assembly, repair the oil cooler, and flush the cooler lines. ^ Fluid that is cloudy or milky or appears to be contaminated with water indicates engine coolant or water contamination. Refer to Engine Coolant/Water in Transmission. See: Transmission and Drivetrain/Automatic Transmission/Transaxle/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures Page 4411 4. Use a small flat-blade tool to slide the terminal position assurance (TPA) up one notch on both ends of the connector. The TPA is located underneath the wire dress cover. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 2826 Behind The Center Of The I/P (With RPO Code Z88 & Z89) Page 5185 2. Locate the nose piece locking tabs that are positioned on the side of the connector nose piece. The connector nose piece acts as a terminal positive assurance (TPA) and may be referred to as such. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to push in one of the locking tabs while gently pulling on the same side of the nose piece. 4. Repeat the procedure for the other locking tab and remove the nose piece. 5. Remove the wire dress cover. The following is a general procedure for wire dress cover removal. Use this procedure as a guide, some dress cover removal procedures may vary. 6. Use fingers to squeeze the 2 locking legs of the cover. Page 5458 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully raise the TPA on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA cannot be removed from the connector while there are terminals present in the connector body. View of the TPA when removed from the connector body. 4. Use the J 38125-12A tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the left side of the terminal release cavity as shown in the graphic. Use the tool to move the terminal release to the right with a gentle prying motion. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 2254 MOLEX CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. 2. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. Page 7812 9. The illustration shows a cutaway view of the connector to aid the technician in releasing the terminal retainer. 10. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Terminal Position Assurance Locks TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Tyco/Amp Connectors (CM 42-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (CM 42-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the connector body and pull the CPA out. The CPA is on the wire harness side of connector. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 6459 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully raise the TPA on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA cannot be removed from the connector while there are terminals present in the connector body. View of the TPA when removed from the connector body. 4. Use the J 38125-12A tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the left side of the terminal release cavity as shown in the graphic. Use the tool to move the terminal release to the right with a gentle prying motion. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Campaign - Unwanted Repeat Calls to OnStar(R) Technical Service Bulletin # 10037 Date: 100420 Campaign - Unwanted Repeat Calls to OnStar(R) CUSTOMER SATISFACTION Bulletin No.: 10037 Date: April 20, 2010 Subject: 10037 - Unwanted Repeat Calls to OnStar(R) Models: 2003 Buick LeSabre 2004-2006 Buick Rendezvous 2005 Buick LeSabre, Terraza 2005-2006 Buick LaCrosse/Allure 2006-2008 Buick Lucerne 2008 Buick LaCrosse/Allure 2008-2009 Buick Enclave 2003 Cadillac CTS 2004 Cadillac Escalade 2004-2005 Cadillac CTS-V, Deville 2005 Cadillac Escalade ESV, SRX 2005-2006 Cadillac STS 2005-2008 Cadillac CTS 2006-2008 Cadillac DTS 2007 Cadillac Escalade, Escalade EXT 2007-2008 Cadillac Escalade ESV 2008 Cadillac SRX, STS 2002 Chevrolet Impala 2003-2008 Chevrolet Suburban 2003-2009 Chevrolet Silverado 2004-2008 Chevrolet Impala 2005 Chevrolet Colorado, Corvette, Malibu 2005-2006 Chevrolet Uplander 2005-2008 Chevrolet Avalanche, Tahoe, TrailBlazer 2006 Chevrolet HHR, Monte Carlo 2006-2008 Chevrolet Equinox 2007-2008 Chevrolet Corvette 2008 Chevrolet HHR 2008-2009 Chevrolet Cobalt, Colorado, Malibu, Uplander 2003 GMC Envoy XL, Sierra, Yukon XL 2004-2008 GMC Yukon 2005-2009 GMC Sierra 2005-2008 GMC Yukon XL 2006-2008 GMC Envoy 2007 GMC Canyon 2007-2009 GMC Acadia 2006 HUMMER H2 2006-2008 HUMMER H3 2008 HUMMER H2 2003 Oldsmobile Silhouette 2005 Montana SV6 2005-2008 Pontiac Grand Prix 2006 Pontiac G6, Vibe 2007 Pontiac Montana SV6 2007-2008 Pontiac Solstice 2008 Pontiac G6, Torrent 2008-2009 Pontiac G5, G8 2009 Pontiac G3, Montana SV6 2005-2007 Saturn ION 2006-2009Saturn VUE 2007-2008 Saturn AURA, OUTLOOK, SKY Equipped with OnStar(R) (RPO UE1) Page 5999 9. The illustration shows a cutaway view of the connector to aid the technician in releasing the terminal retainer. 10. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Terminal Position Assurance Locks TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Tyco/Amp Connectors (CM 42-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (CM 42-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the connector body and pull the CPA out. The CPA is on the wire harness side of connector. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 3811 Valve Deactivation Solenoid: Description and Operation Cylinder Deactivation (Active Fuel Management) System Description To provide maximum fuel economy under light load driving conditions, the engine control module (ECM) will command the cylinder deactivation system ON to deactivate engine cylinders 1 and 7 on the left bank, and cylinders 4 and 6 on the right bank, switching to a V4 mode. The engine will operate on 8 cylinders, or V8 mode, during engine starting, engine idling, and medium to heavy throttle applications. When commanded ON, the ECM will determine what cylinder is firing, and begin deactivation on the next closest deactivated cylinder in firing order sequence. The Gen IV engine has a firing order of 1-8-7-2-6-5-4-3. If cylinder number 1 is on its combustion event when cylinder deactivation is commanded ON, the next cylinder in the firing order sequence that can be deactivated is cylinder number 7. If cylinder number 5 is on its combustion event when cylinder deactivation is commanded ON, then the next cylinder in the firing order sequence that can be deactivated is cylinder number 4. Cylinder deactivation is accomplished by not allowing the intake and exhaust valves to open on the selected cylinders by using special valve lifters. The deactivation lifters contain spring loaded locking pins that connect the internal pin housing of the lifter to the outer housing. The pin housing contains the lifter plunger and pushrod seat which interfaces with the pushrod. The outer housing contacts the camshaft lobe through a roller. During V8 mode, the locking pins are pushed outward by spring force, locking the pin housing and outer housing together causing the lifter to function as a normal lifter. When V4 mode is commanded ON, the locking pins are pushed inward with engine oil pressure directed from the valve lifter oil manifold (VLOM) assembly solenoids. When the lifter pin housing is unlocked from the outer housing, the internal pin housing will remain stationary, while the outer housing will move with the profile of the camshaft lobe, which results in the valve remaining closed. One VLOM solenoid controls both the intake and exhaust valves for each deactivating cylinder. There are 2 distinct oil passages going to each cylinder deactivation lifter bore, one for the hydraulic lash-adjusting feature of the lifter, and one for controlling the locking pins used for cylinder deactivation. Although both intake and exhaust valve lifters are controlled by the same solenoid in the VLOM, the intake and exhaust valves do not become deactivated at the same time. Cylinder deactivation is timed so that the cylinder is on an intake event. During an intake event, the intake cam lobe is pushing the valve lifter upwards to open the intake valve against the force of the valve spring. The force exerted by the valve spring is acting on the side of the lifter locking pins, preventing them from moving until the intake valve has closed. When the intake valve lifter reaches the base circle of the camshaft lobe, the valve spring force is reduced, allowing the locking pins to move, deactivating the intake valve. However, when cylinder deactivation is commanded ON, the exhaust valve for the deactivated cylinder is in the closed position, allowing the locking pins on the valve lifter to move immediately, and deactivate the exhaust valve. By deactivating the exhaust valve first, this allows the capture of a burnt air/fuel charge or exhaust gas charge in the combustion chamber. The capture of exhaust gases in the combustion chamber will contribute to a reduction in oil consumption, noise and vibration levels, and exhaust emissions when operating in V4 mode. During the transition from V8 to V4 mode, the fuel injectors will be turned OFF on the deactivated cylinders. The ignition system secondary voltage or spark is still present across the spark plug electrodes on the deactivated cylinders. If all enabling conditions are met and maintained for cylinder deactivation operation, the ECM calibrations will limit cylinder deactivation to a cycle time of 10 minutes in V4 mode, and then return to V8 mode for 1 minute. Switching between V8 and V4 mode is accomplished in less than 250 milliseconds, making the transitions seamless and transparent to the vehicle operator. The 250 milliseconds includes the time for the ECM to sequence the transitions, the response time for the VLOM solenoids to energize, and the time for the valve lifters to deactivate, all within 2 revolutions of the engine crankshaft. The cylinder deactivation system consists of the following components: * The VLOM assembly * Eight special valve lifters, 2 per deactivating cylinder * The engine oil pressure regulator valve for cylinder deactivation operation * Gen IV cylinder deactivation engine block * The ECM Valve Lifter Oil Manifold (VLOM) Assembly The cylinder deactivation system uses an electro-hydraulic actuator device called the valve lifter oil manifold (VLOM) assembly. The VLOM is bolted to the top of the engine valley, below the intake manifold assembly. The VLOM consists of 4 electrically operated Normally Closed Solenoids. Each solenoid controls the application of engine oil pressure to the intake and exhaust valve lifters on the cylinders selected to deactivate. Engine oil pressure is routed to the VLOM assembly from a passage on the rear of the cylinder block. All 4 VLOM solenoids are connected in parallel to a fused ignition 1 voltage circuit, supplied by the powertrain relay. The ground or control circuit for each solenoid is connected to the engine control module (ECM). When all enabling conditions are met for cylinder deactivation, the ECM will ground each solenoid control circuit in firing order sequence, allowing current to flow through the solenoid windings. With the coil windings energized, the solenoid valve opens, redirecting engine oil pressure through the VLOM into 8 separate vertical passages in the engine lifter valley. The 8 vertical passages, 2 per cylinder, are connected to the valve lifter bores of the cylinders to be deactivated. When vehicle-operating conditions require a return to V8 mode, the ECM will turn OFF the control circuit for the solenoids, allowing the solenoid valves to close. With the solenoid valves closed, engine oil pressure in the control ports is exhausted through the body of the Page 2125 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Ensure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the Terminal Removal Procedure. Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PULL TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL If the terminal is visibly damaged or is suspected of having a faulty connection, the terminal should be replaced. Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors: 1. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) device and/or the secondary lock. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component or separate the connectors for in-line connectors. 3. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device. 4. Insert the proper pick or removal tool into the front of the connector body. 5. IMPORTANT: On connectors with more than one terminal the service loop may not be large enough to remove the terminal and crimp on a new one. If the terminal wire does not have a large enough service loop for removal, cut the wire 5 cm (2 in) behind the connector before removal. Grasp the wire at the back of the connector body and gently push the terminal out the front of the connector body. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. If the wire needed to be cut in order to remove the terminal, gently push a small length of the same size wire through the back of the connector cavity until there is enough wire exposed in order to crimp on a new terminal. If the wire was not cut, cut the existing wire as close to the old terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 4. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. TERMINAL INSTALLATION 1. Align the terminal and pull the wire from the back of the connector in order to seat the terminal. 2. If necessary, cut the new wire to proper length and splice with existing circuit. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. 3. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply dielectric grease to the connector. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PUSH TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 1931 Page 8354 Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Specifications Temperature Versus Resistance Page 685 to analyze the data during the time a vehicle condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a trigger point that you have determined. Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2 snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a first-in, first-out basis. If a third snapshot is taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost. Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types: Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice - Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200 frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not lost if the Scan Tool is powered down. The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis. The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected values by plotting 3 parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful, especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC. Testing for a Short to Voltage TESTING FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4. Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt, there is a short to voltage in the circuit. Testing for Continuity TESTING FOR CONTINUITY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6. Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit. 7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity. With a Test Lamp IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits. 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6. If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity. Testing for Electrical Intermittents TESTING FOR ELECTRICAL INTERMITTENTS Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment. - Testing for Short to Ground - Testing for Continuity - Testing for a Short to Voltage Specifications Thermostat: Specifications Use the temperature sticks to determine a thermostat's operating temperature by rubbing 87°C(188°F) and 97°C (206°F) sticks on the thermostat housing . The marks made by the sticks should melt when coolant temperatures reach 87°C (188°F) and 97°C (206°F), respectively. These temperatures are the normal operating range of the thermostat. Page 2132 REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. The release tab is located on the top of the wiredress cover. View of connector in released position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Page 2092 Refer to the following table as a guide in selecting the correct test adapter for front probing connectors: Backprobe IMPORTANT: Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures. - Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector. - Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large of a test probe. - After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected, test for proper terminal contact. Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the connector. Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure SCAN TOOL SNAPSHOT PROCEDURE Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used Page 9000 Page 8583 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert a small flat-blade tool in the slot below the front loaded terminal position assurance (TPA) and pry up. 3. Remove the TPA by pulling it out of the connector. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-553 (GM P/N 15315247) on a slight upward angle into the cavity below the terminal to be removed. Ensure that the pointed on the end of the tool is facing the bottom of the terminal and it stays in contact with the terminal until it stops on the plastic terminal retainer. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 8675 - JST connectors have JST in small letters on their connectors, similar to that above. The location of the logo will vary with the connector size and style. - Kostel has an "LK" with a circle around it. These connector are usually used as a transmissions connection and are currently use on some Cadillac vehicles. Page 5674 3. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. View showing depressing of the lever lock release tab. Page 3753 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Ensure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the Terminal Removal Procedure. Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PULL TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL If the terminal is visibly damaged or is suspected of having a faulty connection, the terminal should be replaced. Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors: 1. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) device and/or the secondary lock. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component or separate the connectors for in-line connectors. 3. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device. 4. Insert the proper pick or removal tool into the front of the connector body. 5. IMPORTANT: On connectors with more than one terminal the service loop may not be large enough to remove the terminal and crimp on a new one. If the terminal wire does not have a large enough service loop for removal, cut the wire 5 cm (2 in) behind the connector before removal. Grasp the wire at the back of the connector body and gently push the terminal out the front of the connector body. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. If the wire needed to be cut in order to remove the terminal, gently push a small length of the same size wire through the back of the connector cavity until there is enough wire exposed in order to crimp on a new terminal. If the wire was not cut, cut the existing wire as close to the old terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 4. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. TERMINAL INSTALLATION 1. Align the terminal and pull the wire from the back of the connector in order to seat the terminal. 2. If necessary, cut the new wire to proper length and splice with existing circuit. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. 3. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply dielectric grease to the connector. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PUSH TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 6566 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the TPA. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the nose piece. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. Page 7869 Body Control Module (BCM) C2 Page 2039 2. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully push the terminal position assurance (TPA) towards the face of the connector on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA is fragile and may break if not done carefully. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. 3. Use the J 38125-215 tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 1843 Refer to the following table as a guide in selecting the correct test adapter for front probing connectors: Backprobe IMPORTANT: Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures. - Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector. - Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large of a test probe. - After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected, test for proper terminal contact. Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the connector. Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure SCAN TOOL SNAPSHOT PROCEDURE Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used Page 2768 Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair Valve Body and Pressure Switch Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Ensure that removal of the valve body is necessary before proceeding. The following components can be serviced without removing the valve body from the transmission: ^ The torque converter clutch solenoid (1) ^ The pressure control solenoid (2) ^ The internal wiring harness (3) ^ The 2-3 shift solenoid (4) ^ The 1-2 shift solenoid (5) ^ The transmission fluid pressure manual valve position switch (6) ^ The 3-2 shift solenoid (7) ^ The torque converter clutch (TCC) pulse width modulation (PWM) solenoid (8) 2. Remove the fluid level indicator. 3. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 4. Remove the oil pan, gasket, and filter. Refer to Automatic Transmission Fluid and Filter Replacement. 5. Disconnect the internal wiring harness electrical connectors from the following components: ^ The transmission fluid pressure manual valve position switch (1) ^ The 1-2 shift solenoid (2) ^ The 2-3 shift solenoid (3) ^ The pressure control solenoid (4) ^ The TCC PWM solenoid (5) ^ The 3-2 shift solenoid (6) ^ The input speed sensor, if equipped Page 3733 5. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove TPA from the connector. 6. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Page 5686 - Kostel - Molex - Sumitomo - Tyco/AMP - Yazaki Identifying the manufacturer of a connector is often difficult. When trying to determine the manufacturer of a connector, look for specific identifying marks that are unique to that connector supplier. Most of these identify marks are hard to find or see. Check the connector carefully and refer to the information below for pictures and descriptions of connector identification markings. - Most of AFLs connectors have EPC on their connector body. Some of the smaller connectors will not have any markings on them. - In some cases Bosch will actually be printed on the connector. If Bosch does not appear on the connector, look for the Bosch logo. The Bosch logo is a circle with a blunted arrow inside. This logo can appear anywhere on the connector and is often very small. Page 5691 View of a typical Micro 64 connector. Depress the lock and pull the lever over and past the lock. Page 683 IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals. Front probe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the connector. IMPORTANT: When probing female 0.64 terminals, it is important to use the correct adapter. There have been some revisions to the test adapter for 0.64 terminals. The proper adapter for 0.64 terminals is the J 35616-64B which has a gold terminal and a black wire between the base and tip. Failure to use the proper test adapter may result in damage to the terminal being tested and improper diagnosis. NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Page 4174 9. Disconnect the following electrical connectors: ^ Evaporative emission (EVAP) purge solenoid (3) ^ Throttle body harness (5) ^ Manifold absolute pressure (MAP) sensor (2) ^ Main coil (1) ^ Generator (4) 10. Remove the electrical harness clips from the fuel rail. 11. Remove the positive crankcase ventilation (PCV) hose. Page 3760 REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. The release tab is located on the top of the wiredress cover. View of connector in released position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Page 1539 under pressure if the radiator cap or the surge tank cap is removed while the engine and radiator are still hot. 4. Remove the surge tank fill cap from the surge tank or the coolant pressure cap from the radiator. 5. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle in SI. 6. Place a clean drain pan under the radiator drain cock or under the lower radiator hose depending on the vehicle. Refer to Cooling System Draining and Filling in SI. 7. Loosen the radiator drain cock if equipped or use J 38185 clamp pliers and reposition the clamp on the lower radiator hose at the radiator. 8. Remove the end of the lower radiator hose from the radiator. 9. Drain the engine coolant sufficiently below the level of the ECT sensor. 10. Close the radiator drain cock or connect the lower radiator hose at the radiator. 11. Use the J 38185 clamp pliers to place the clamp into the original position on the hose. 12. Lower the vehicle. 13. Disconnect the wiring harness connector from the ECT sensor (2). 14. Remove the ECT sensor (1) from the front of the cylinder head. 15. Remove the corresponding size plug at the rear of the OTHER cylinder head. 16. Coat the threads of the ECT sensor with sealer. Use GM P/N 12346004 (Canadian P/N 10953480) or an equivalent. 17. Install the ECT sensor in the hole of the cylinder head where the plug was removed. Tighten Tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb ft). 18. Coat the threads of the plug with sealer. Use GM P/N 12346004 (Canadian P/N 10953480) or an equivalent. 19. Install the plug in the hole of the cylinder head where the ECT sensor was removed Tighten Tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb ft). Important Leave enough wire attached to the ECT sensor harness connector in order to create manageable splices that are at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splice. Page 6513 Page 1598 2. Locate the nose piece locking tabs that are positioned on the side of the connector nose piece. The connector nose piece acts as a terminal positive assurance (TPA) and may be referred to as such. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to push in one of the locking tabs while gently pulling on the same side of the nose piece. 4. Repeat the procedure for the other locking tab and remove the nose piece. 5. Remove the wire dress cover. The following is a general procedure for wire dress cover removal. Use this procedure as a guide, some dress cover removal procedures may vary. 6. Use fingers to squeeze the 2 locking legs of the cover. Page 8282 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. JST Connectors JST CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, remove the connector from the component. Page 1731 4. Once the front 2 locks are unlocked, lift the front of the dress cover and pull it forward. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the small slot on the TPA and pushing down until the TPA releases. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to angle or rock the J 38125-21 tool when inserting it into the connector or the tool may break. Insert the J 38125-21 (GM P/N 15381651-2) tool into the round canal between the terminals cavities at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to repair Micro 64 connector terminals. The Micro 64 connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-64 (M jaw) was developed to crimp Micro 64 terminals. The J 38125-64 crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. The J 38125-64 crimping tool is also designed to crimp both the wire and the insulation at the same time. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro 64 terminals. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. 1. Cut the wire as close to the damaged terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. Page 6970 1. Locate the air flow direction arrow (2) on the MAF/IAT sensor. 2. Install the MAF/IAT sensor on to the air cleaner housing. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 3. Tighten the clamp securing the MAF/IAT sensor to the air cleaner housing. Tighten the clamp to 7 N.m (62 lb in). 4. Install the air cleaner outlet duct. 5. Install the air cleaner outlet duct bolt. Tighten the bolt to 10 N.m (89 lb in). 6. Tighten the clamps at the MAF/IAT sensor and the throttle body. Tighten the clamps to 7 N.m (62 lb in). Page 6203 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. 4. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front of the connector. Page 421 4. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the rear of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. 5. Once the locking tabs are unlocked, slide the inner connector out of the rear of the connector housing. Page 1978 Release the tabs that are holding the wiredress cover to the connector body. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the slots on both ends of the connector body. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. J 38125-216 can also be used to remove the nose piece. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by lifting the terminal retaining tabs on the inside of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 1357 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. JST Connectors JST CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, remove the connector from the component. Capacity Specifications Fluid - Differential: Capacity Specifications DIFFERENTIAL FLUID Front Axle ...................................................................................................... ......................................................................................... 0.8 liters (1.7 pints) Rear Axle ................... .............................................................................................................................................................. ............... 2.0 liters (4.3 pints) NOTE: With a complete drain/refill, add 163 ml (5.5 oz) of Limited Slip Axle Lubricant to the axle in addition to the axle lubricant. IMPORTANT: The lubricant level should be between 0 - 10 mm (0 - 0.4 in) below the fill plug opening. NOTE: All capacities are approximate. When adding, be sure to fill to the approximate level. Recheck fluid level after filling. Engine Controls - MIL ON/Misfire/Misfire DTC's Set Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Engine Controls - MIL ON/Misfire/Misfire DTC's Set Bulletin No.: 06-06-04-046 Date: September 12, 2006 INFORMATION Subject: Information on Engine Misfire MIL/SES Light Illuminated or Flashing DTC P0300, P0301, P0302, P0303, P0304, P0305, P0306, P0307, P0308, P0420 or P0430 Models: 1999-2007 Cadillac, Chevrolet, GMC Full-Size Pickup and/or Utility Trucks with 4.8L, 5.3L, 5.7L, 6.0L or 6.2L VORTEC GEN III, GEN IV, V-8 Engine (VINs V, C, T, Z, B, 3, M, 0, J, R, U, N, Y, K, 8 - RPOs LR4, LY2, LM7, L59, L33, LC9, LH6, LMG, LY5, L31, LQ4, LQ9, L76, LY6, L92) with Active Fuel Management(TM) and E85 Flex Fuel If you encounter vehicles that exhibit the above conditions, refer to SI for the appropriate DTC(s) set. If no trouble is found, the cause may be due to an ECM ground terminal that has corroded with rust over time. Inspect the main engine wiring harness ground terminal (G103) for this condition. The wire terminal (G103) attaches either to the front or to the rear of the right side cylinder head, depending on the model year of the Full Size Pickup and/or Utility Trucks. If the ECM ground terminal has been found to be corroded, then follow the service procedure outlined in this bulletin to correct the corrosion issue. Remove either the nut or bolt securing the main engine wiring harness ground terminal (G103) to the right cylinder head. Refer to the above illustration to determine where the ground is located on the vehicle (1). Page 4549 2. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully push the terminal position assurance (TPA) towards the face of the connector on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA is fragile and may break if not done carefully. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. 3. Use the J 38125-215 tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 6344 REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. The release tab is located on the top of the wiredress cover. View of connector in released position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Page 4324 3. Position the coolant air bleed hose clamp at the heater outlet hose. 4. Fill the cooling system, if necessary. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System (LL8) Draining and Filling Cooling System (LH6, LS2). Page 5982 REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. The release tab is located on the top of the wiredress cover. View of connector in released position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Page 3176 Engine Oil: Fluid Type Specifications ENGINE OIL TYPE LOOK FOR TWO THINGS: 1.Your vehicle's engine requires oil meeting GM Standard GM6094M. 2.SAE 5W-30 is best for your vehicle. These numbers on an oil container show its viscosity, or thickness. Do not use other viscosity oils such as SAE 20W-50. Oils meeting these requirements should also have the starburst symbol on the container. This symbol indicates that the oil has been certified by the American Petroleum Institute (API). You should look for this information on the oil container, and use only those oils that are identified as meeting GM Standard GM6094M and have the starburst symbol on the front of the oil container. NOTICE: Use only engine oil identified as meeting GM Standard GM6094M and showing the American Petroleum Institute Certified For Gasoline Engines starburst symbol. Failure to use the recommended oil can result in engine damage not covered by your warranty. GM Goodwrench oil meets all the requirements for your vehicle. If you are in an area of extreme cold, where the temperature falls below -20°F (-29°C), it is recommended that you use either an SAE 5W-30 synthetic oil or an SAE 0W-30 oil. Both will provide easier cold starting and better protection for your engine at extremely low temperatures. ENGINE OIL ADDITIVES Do not add anything to your oil. The recommended oils with the starburst symbol that meet GM Standard GM6094M are all you will need for good performance and engine protection. Page 6117 MOLEX CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. 2. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. Page 8416 Release the lower wiredress cover locking tab. Release the upper wiredress cover locking tab. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. Page 8923 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert terminal into the appropriate terminal holder until it hits bottom and stops. The correct terminal holder is determined by the wire size. Also ensure that the terminals wings are pointing towards the former on the tool and the release locator. 5. Insert the stripped cable into the terminal. Insulation should be visible on both sides of the terminal insulation wings. 6. Compress the handles until the ratchet automatically releases. 7. Place the terminal into the appropriate cavity and assemble the connector. Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO-PACK 100W) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W connectors. These connectors are very similar but use different terminals and have some minor physical differences also. Page 254 Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size. REPAIRING A FUSIBLE LINK IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient overload protection. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. Flat Wire Repairs FLAT WIRE REPAIRS NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced. GMLAN Wiring Repairs GMLAN WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The GM Local Area Network (GMLAN) System requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working on GMLAN connectors and terminals. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items in order to repair the GMLAN wiring: Dura Seal splice sleeves - A wire stripping tool - J 38125-8 Crimping Tool (GM P/N 12085115) - J 38125-5 Ultra Torch Special Tool (GM P/N 12085116) The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. - A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors GMLAN REPAIRS IMPORTANT: When making a repair to any GMLAN network, the original wire length after the repair must be the same length as before the repair. If the network is a twisted pair, the twist must be maintained after the repair is completed. GMLAN has 2 types of networks, low speed and high speed. Low speed GMLAN has a single wire and works at slow speeds. High speed GMLAN has 2 wires in a twisted pair and works at higher speeds. For more information on GMLAN, refer to Data Link Communications Description and Operation. GMLAN CONNECTOR TERMINAL REPAIR IMPORTANT: A service terminal can be used to replace damaged connector terminals for both high speed and low speed GMLAN systems. When making a connector terminal repair on a GMLAN high speed system with twisted pair wires, do not untwist the wires more than necessary to make the repair. The terminals in the GMLAN system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are available in the J-38125. If the individual terminals are damaged on any GMLAN connection, use the appropriate connector repair procedure in order to repair the terminal. GMLAN WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 7514 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the TPA. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the nose piece. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. Page 6677 11. Insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) into the 2 triangular cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 12. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE 1. Prior to installation the terminal must be aligned so the (1) coding lugs align with the (2) coding grooves on the connector. 2. Once the terminal is aligned, slide the terminal into the cavity until the retainer has engaged in the cavity of the connector. 3. Slide the TPA in the connector body and seat it using a small flat bladed tool. The TPA is seated when it is flush with the contact housing. 4. Secure the wires to the connector body using a tie wrap and replace the dress cover and grommet. Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) BOSCH CONNECTORS (2.8 JPT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Pull out the slider on the connector position assurance (CPA) until it is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 3731 difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Bosch Connectors (ECM) BOSCH CONNECTORS (ECM) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the assist lever on the top of the connector. Move the assist lever to the forward position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 269 Page 8179 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Locations Windshield Washer Relay: Locations Fuse Block - Underhood (5.3L/6.0L), Label Page 7567 Body Control System Diagram 1 (1 Of 3) Diagram Information and Instructions Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay: Diagram Information and Instructions Electrical Symbols Page 7093 11. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 12. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 13. Center the high temperature SCT1 shrink tube over the DuraSeal splice sleeve. 14. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the high temperature heat shrink tubing. 15. Gradually move the heat from the center to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 16. Replace any reflective tape and clips that may have been remove during the repair. Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation REPAIRING DAMAGED WIRE INSULATION Wire Size Conversion Page 7703 Knock Sensor: Service and Repair Knock Sensor Replacement (Right Side) Knock Sensor Replacement (Right Side) Removal Procedure 1. Disconnect the electrical connector (3) from the knock sensor (2). 2. Remove the knock sensor bolt (1). 3. Remove the knock sensor (2) from the engine block. Installation Procedure 1. Position the knock sensor (2) on the engine block. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Install the knock sensor bolt (1). Tighten the bolt (1) to 20 N.m (15 lb ft). 3. Connect the electrical connector (3) to the knock sensor (2). Page 6338 TERMINAL REMOVAL Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors. 1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA) device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1). 3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 4. Gently pull the cable and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector. 5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal, refer to Terminal Repair. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3. Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector. REINSTALLING TERMINAL 1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly, refer to Wiring Repairs. 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3. Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) DELPHI CONNECTORS (WEATHER PACK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 2161 6. Gently pry the plastic terminal retainer down and carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (16-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, pull the two connector halves apart. Page 8176 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. 4. Remove the dress cover by using a flat bladed tool to release the dress cover locking tabs and lift up on the dress cover. 5. Cut the tie wrap that holds the wires to the connector body. Page 4000 Step 7 - Step 13 Page 2271 Release the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the blue locking tabs on both ends of the connector. Gently slide the TPA up to the released position on both ends. 6. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-13A (GM P/N 12031876-1) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. Page 753 6. Gently pry the plastic terminal retainer down and carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (16-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, pull the two connector halves apart. Page 7582 Step 1 - Step 9 Page 6099 7. Apply pressure and gently rock the cover until one locking leg is unseated. 8. Continue to apply pressure and rock the cover until the second locking leg is unseated. Repeat procedure for the other side of the dress cover and remove the cover. 9. Use J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) to gently lift the terminal retaining tab while gently pulling the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 10. If the terminal is severely bent or damaged, it may be possible on some connectors to push the wire out of the front of the connector instead of Page 1873 2. Locate the nose piece locking tabs that are positioned on the side of the connector nose piece. The connector nose piece acts as a terminal positive assurance (TPA) and may be referred to as such. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to push in one of the locking tabs while gently pulling on the same side of the nose piece. 4. Repeat the procedure for the other locking tab and remove the nose piece. 5. Remove the wire dress cover. The following is a general procedure for wire dress cover removal. Use this procedure as a guide, some dress cover removal procedures may vary. 6. Use fingers to squeeze the 2 locking legs of the cover. Diagram Information and Instructions Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions Electrical Symbols Campaign - Unwanted Repeat Calls to OnStar(R) Technical Service Bulletin # 10037 Date: 100420 Campaign - Unwanted Repeat Calls to OnStar(R) CUSTOMER SATISFACTION Bulletin No.: 10037 Date: April 20, 2010 Subject: 10037 - Unwanted Repeat Calls to OnStar(R) Models: 2003 Buick LeSabre 2004-2006 Buick Rendezvous 2005 Buick LeSabre, Terraza 2005-2006 Buick LaCrosse/Allure 2006-2008 Buick Lucerne 2008 Buick LaCrosse/Allure 2008-2009 Buick Enclave 2003 Cadillac CTS 2004 Cadillac Escalade 2004-2005 Cadillac CTS-V, Deville 2005 Cadillac Escalade ESV, SRX 2005-2006 Cadillac STS 2005-2008 Cadillac CTS 2006-2008 Cadillac DTS 2007 Cadillac Escalade, Escalade EXT 2007-2008 Cadillac Escalade ESV 2008 Cadillac SRX, STS 2002 Chevrolet Impala 2003-2008 Chevrolet Suburban 2003-2009 Chevrolet Silverado 2004-2008 Chevrolet Impala 2005 Chevrolet Colorado, Corvette, Malibu 2005-2006 Chevrolet Uplander 2005-2008 Chevrolet Avalanche, Tahoe, TrailBlazer 2006 Chevrolet HHR, Monte Carlo 2006-2008 Chevrolet Equinox 2007-2008 Chevrolet Corvette 2008 Chevrolet HHR 2008-2009 Chevrolet Cobalt, Colorado, Malibu, Uplander 2003 GMC Envoy XL, Sierra, Yukon XL 2004-2008 GMC Yukon 2005-2009 GMC Sierra 2005-2008 GMC Yukon XL 2006-2008 GMC Envoy 2007 GMC Canyon 2007-2009 GMC Acadia 2006 HUMMER H2 2006-2008 HUMMER H3 2008 HUMMER H2 2003 Oldsmobile Silhouette 2005 Montana SV6 2005-2008 Pontiac Grand Prix 2006 Pontiac G6, Vibe 2007 Pontiac Montana SV6 2007-2008 Pontiac Solstice 2008 Pontiac G6, Torrent 2008-2009 Pontiac G5, G8 2009 Pontiac G3, Montana SV6 2005-2007 Saturn ION 2006-2009Saturn VUE 2007-2008 Saturn AURA, OUTLOOK, SKY Equipped with OnStar(R) (RPO UE1) Caster Description Alignment: Description and Operation Caster Description Caster Description Caster Description Caster is the tilting of the uppermost point of the steering axis either forward or backward, when viewed from the side of the vehicle. A backward tilt is positive (+) and a forward tilt is negative (-). Caster influences directional control of the steering but does not affect the tire wear. Caster is affected by the vehicle height, therefore it is important to keep the body at its designed height. Overloading the vehicle or a weak or sagging rear spring will affect caster. When the rear of the vehicle is lower than its designated trim height, the front suspension moves to a more positive caster. If the rear of the vehicle is higher than its designated trim height, the front suspension moves to a less positive caster. With too little positive caster, steering may be touchy at high speed and wheel returnability may be diminished when coming out of a turn. If one wheel has more positive caster than the other, that wheel will pull toward the center of the vehicle. This condition will cause the vehicle to pull or lead to the side with the least amount of positive caster. Page 4561 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link). - The wire insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. 5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold them between thumb and forefinger. 7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place. - Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction. - Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip. 8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool closes.Ensure that no strands of wire are cut. 10. Crimp the splice on each end (2). Page 8355 Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Locations Engine Controls Component Views Left Side of Engine - Front 1 - Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor 2 - G108 Page 3156 4. Install the ground, then the washer and then the bolt to the frame. Important: It is important to use the bolts, washers and nuts specified in this bulletin. These parts have been identified due to their conductive finish. 5. Install a washer and nut to the back side of the frame. Tighten Tighten the nut to 9 Nm (79 lb in). 6. Cover the front and back side of the repair area using Rubberized Undercoating. An additional check can be made to ensure a good connection for the battery cable to frame ground. It is possible for this ground to cause similar symptoms with the ABS as described above. *We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may be available from other sources. Parts Information Warranty Information Disclaimer Page 5376 6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias. Reference the appropriate service manual wiring schematic to obtain the correct diode installation position. 7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for the soldering equipment. 8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed. 9. IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode attachment points with tape. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape. Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable SPLICING TWISTED OR SHIELDED CABLE Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable. 1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splice is made. 3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire. Staggering the splices by 65 mm (2.5 in) is recommended. 4. IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical contact with the drain wire. Re-assemble the cable. Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape. - Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1). - Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire. - Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape. Page 8567 8. Insert the J 38125-213 into the small terminal release hole on the nose piece and gently pull on the back of the wire. 9. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Repairing Connector Terminals REPAIRING CONNECTOR TERMINALS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following: Push to Seat terminals - Pull to Seat terminals Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your terminal repair. The J-38125 contains further information. 1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.For cable seal terminals, remove the seal. 2. Apply the correct cable seal per gage size of the wire, if used.Slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation removal. 3. Remove the insulation. 4. For sealed terminals only, align the seal with the end of the cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal.For sealed terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal. 6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.For sealed terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable. 8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals excepting Micro-Pack 100.64 size. Soldering Micro-Pack 100 World terminals may damage the terminal. Sumitomo Connectors SUMITOMO CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 2210 Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested: - Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. - Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a component or to other harnesses. - If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A TEST LAMP TOOLS REQUIRED J 35616-200 Test Light - Probe Kit NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminate even though voltage is present. The J 35616-200 is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair of leads. To properly operate this tool use the following procedures. When testing for voltage: 1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested. When testing for ground: 1. Attach one lead to battery positive voltage. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where ground should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is ground at the point being tested. Using Connector Test Adapters USING CONNECTOR TEST ADAPTERS NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Using Fused Jumper Wires USING FUSED JUMPER WIRES TOOLS REQUIRED J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged. The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested. AFL/ECP Connectors AFL/EPC CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 2091 IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals. Front probe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the connector. IMPORTANT: When probing female 0.64 terminals, it is important to use the correct adapter. There have been some revisions to the test adapter for 0.64 terminals. The proper adapter for 0.64 terminals is the J 35616-64B which has a gold terminal and a black wire between the base and tip. Failure to use the proper test adapter may result in damage to the terminal being tested and improper diagnosis. NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Page 5749 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link). - The wire insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. 5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold them between thumb and forefinger. 7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place. - Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction. - Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip. 8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool closes.Ensure that no strands of wire are cut. 10. Crimp the splice on each end (2). Page 2099 3. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. View showing depressing of the lever lock release tab. Page 6501 5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape. Seat Belt Schematic Icons Seat Belt Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons Secondary/Configurable Control Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons SIR Schematic Icons Page 4808 4. Once the front 2 locks are unlocked, lift the front of the dress cover and pull it forward. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the small slot on the TPA and pushing down until the TPA releases. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to angle or rock the J 38125-21 tool when inserting it into the connector or the tool may break. Insert the J 38125-21 (GM P/N 15381651-2) tool into the round canal between the terminals cavities at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to repair Micro 64 connector terminals. The Micro 64 connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-64 (M jaw) was developed to crimp Micro 64 terminals. The J 38125-64 crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. The J 38125-64 crimping tool is also designed to crimp both the wire and the insulation at the same time. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro 64 terminals. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. 1. Cut the wire as close to the damaged terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. Page 4932 4. Use a small flat-blade tool to slide the terminal position assurance (TPA) up one notch on both ends of the connector. The TPA is located underneath the wire dress cover. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 4625 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) and slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. Page 524 3. Remove the dress cover by using a flat-blade tool to release the connector locking tabs and pulling off the dress cover. 4. Relieve the tension on the nose piece retainers by inserting J-38125-12A (12094429) into the single retainer slot on the end of the nose piece and gently prying out the locking tab. Repeat the process for both of the nose piece locking tabs on the opposite side of the nose piece. Page 1544 Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Locations Engine Controls Component Views Left Side of Engine - Front 1 - Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor 2 - G108 Page 8104 Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Service and Repair Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure Notice: Handle the electronic throttle control components carefully. Use cleanliness in order to prevent damage. Do not drop the electronic throttle control components. Do not roughly handle the electronic throttle control components. Do not immerse the electronic throttle control components in cleaning solvents of any type. 1. Disconnect the accelerator pedal position (APP) sensor electrical connector. 2. Remove the 3 APP sensor bolts (1). 3. Remove the APP sensor (2). Installation Procedure 1. Install the APP sensor. Page 7537 4. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the rear of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. 5. Once the locking tabs are unlocked, slide the inner connector out of the rear of the connector housing. Page 1962 Throttle Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids Arrows and Symbols Arrows and Symbols This Service Data uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations. Arrows and Symbols 1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow Basic Knowledge Required GENERAL ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures contained in the service manual. You should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current (amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram, as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. Decimal and Metric Equivalents Decimal and Metric Equivalents Page 7659 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry one side of the nose piece up to the pre-stage position. When the nose piece is in the pre-staged position, the nose piece will be raised above the connector body the length of the step in the nose piece. 7. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry the other side of the piece to the pre-stage position. If the nose piece is higher than the first step in the nose piece, gently push down on the nose piece until it meets with resistance from the connector body, you should feel the nose piece click into position. Page 6643 1 - Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor 2 - Knock Sensor (KS) 2 - Right 3 - Engine Harness 4 Starter 5 - Engine Page 3634 Do not use cleaning solutions that contain hydrofluoric, oxalic and most other acids on chrome wheels (or any wheels). If the customer is unsure of the chemical make-up of a particular wheel cleaner, it should be avoided. For wheels showing signs of milky staining from acidic cleaners, refer to Customer Assistance and Instructions below. Warranty of Stained Chrome Wheels Stained wheels are not warrantable. Most acid based cleaners will permanently stain chrome wheels. Follow-up with dealers has confirmed that such cleaners were used on wheels that were returned to the Warranty Parts Center (WPC). Any stained wheels received by the WPC will be charged back to the dealership. To assist the customer, refer to Customer Assistance and Instructions below. Pitting or Spotted Appearance of Chrome Wheels Figure 2 A second type or staining or finish disturbance may result from road chemicals, such as calcium chloride used for dust control of unpaved roads. The staining will look like small pitting (refer to Figure 2). This staining will usually be on the leading edges of each wheel spoke, but may be uniformly distributed. If a vehicle must be operated under such conditions, the chrome wheels should be washed with mild soap and water and thoroughly rinsed as soon as conveniently possible. Important Road chemicals, such as calcium chloride used for dust control of unpaved roads, can also stain chrome wheels. The staining will look like small pitting. This staining will usually be on the leading edges of each wheel spoke. This is explained by the vehicle traveling in the forward direction while being splashed by the road chemical. If a vehicle must be operated under such conditions, the chrome wheels should be washed with mild soap and water and thoroughly rinsed as soon as conveniently possible. Warranty of Pitted or Spotted Chrome Wheels Wheels returned with pitting or spotting as a result of road chemicals may be replaced one time. Damage resulting from contact with these applied road chemicals is corrosive to the wheels finish and may cause damage if the wheels are not kept clean. Important Notify the customer that this is a one time replacement. Please stress to the customer the vital importance of keeping the wheels clean if they are operating the vehicle in an area that applies calcium chloride or other dust controlling chemicals! "GM of Canada" dealers require prior approval by the District Manager - Customer Care and Service Process (DM-CCSP). "Stardust" Corrosion of Chrome Wheels Figure 3 A third type of finish disturbance results from prolonged exposure to brake dust and resultant penetration of brake dust through the chrome. As brakes are applied hot particles of brake material are thrown off and tend to be forced through the leading edge of the wheel spoke windows by airflow. These Specifications Oil Pan: Specifications Oil Pan Front Cover Alignment at Oil Pan Surface ............................................................................................................................... .................................. 0.0-0.5 mm (0.0-0.02 in) Crankshaft Rear Oil Seal Housing Alignment at Oil Pan Surface ............................................................................................................................... ................................. 0.0-0.5 mm (0.0-0.02 in) Oil Pan Alignment - to Rear of Engine Block at Transmission Bell Housing Mounting Surface ............................................................................................................... 0.0-0.1 mm (0.0-0.004 in) Oil Pan Baffle Bolts .............................................................................................................................. ................................................... 12 N.m (106 lb in) Oil Pan Closeout Cover Bolt Left Side .............................................................................................................................................. ..................................................... 9 N.m (80 lb in) Right Side ............................................................ ..................................................................................................................................... 9 N.m (80 lb in) Oil Pan Cover Bolts ............................................................................................................................. ..................................................... 12 N.m (106 lb in) Oil Pan Drain Plug ........................................... ........................................................................................................................................... 25 N.m (18 lb ft) Oil Pan M6 Bolts Oil Pan-to-Rear Housing ..................................................................................................................... ................................................. 12 N.m (106 lb in) Oil Pan M8 Bolts Oil Pan-to-Engine Block and Oil Pan-to-Front Cover ............................................................................................................................ 25 N.m (18 lb ft) Oil Pan Oil Gallery Plugs ..................................................................................................................... ....................................................... 25 N.m (18 lb ft) Page 3832 3. Remove the 3 bolts from the camshaft. 9. Clean and inspect the camshaft and bearings. Refer to Camshaft and Bearings Cleaning and Inspection. Installation Procedure Important: If camshaft replacement is required, the valve lifters must also be replaced. 1. Lubricate the camshaft journals and the bearings with clean engine oil. Notice: All camshaft journals are the same diameter, so care must be used in removing or installing the camshaft to avoid damage to the camshaft bearings. 2. Install three M8-1.25 x 100 mm (M8-1.25 x 4.0 in) bolts to the bolt holes in the front of the camshaft. 3. Using the bolts as a handle, carefully install the camshaft into the engine block. 4. Remove the 3 bolts from the front of the camshaft. Important: Install the retainer plate with the sealing gasket facing the engine block. The gasket surface on the engine block should be clean and free of dirt and/or debris. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 5. Install the camshaft retainer and bolts. Tighten the bolts to 25 N.m (18 lb ft). Page 6503 Page 3349 Page 7011 Checking Aftermarket Accessories CHECKING AFTERMARKET ACCESSORIES Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits: - CAUTION: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol. - NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice. OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol. Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the cause of the problems. Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include: Power feeds connected to points other than the battery - Antenna location - Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring - Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line - Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories. Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions INDUCING INTERMITTENT FAULT CONDITIONS TOOLS REQUIRED J 25070 Heat Gun Many intermittent open or shorted circuits are affected by harness/connector movement that is caused by vibration, engine torque, bumps/rough pavement, etc. In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness if the malfunction appears to be Page 9079 6. Gently pry the plastic terminal retainer down and carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (16-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, pull the two connector halves apart. Page 6615 US English/Metric Conversion US English/Metric Conversion Page 2820 Behind The Center Of The I/P (With RPO Code W49) Page 5811 View of connector in released position. 4. Disconnect the connector from the component. 5. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Release the rear lower half of the wiredress cover. Page 443 11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the solder equipment. 12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. 13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to cover the first piece of tape. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE SLEEVES TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit IMPORTANT: Use only dura seal splice sleeves. Other splice sleeves may not protect the splice from moisture or provide a good electrical connection. Use duraseal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. Use duraseal splice sleeves where there is special requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire using duraseal splice sleeves. Page 6342 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the TPA. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the nose piece. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. Page 6961 11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the solder equipment. 12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. 13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to cover the first piece of tape. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE SLEEVES TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit IMPORTANT: Use only dura seal splice sleeves. Other splice sleeves may not protect the splice from moisture or provide a good electrical connection. Use duraseal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. Use duraseal splice sleeves where there is special requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire using duraseal splice sleeves. Page 2539 For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 3081 For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table above. Disclaimer Page 8213 US English/Metric Conversion US English/Metric Conversion Page 7378 4. Slide the dress cover forward and off of the connector. 5. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front and rear of the connector. Page 6038 Oxygen Sensor: Service Precautions Excessive Force and Oxygen Sensor Notice Excessive Force and Oxygen Sensor Notice Notice: The oxygen sensor may be difficult to remove when the engine temperature is below 48°C (120°F). Excessive force may damage threads in the exhaust manifold or the exhaust pipe. Tire Monitor System - TPM Sensor Information Tire Pressure Monitor Receiver / Transponder: Technical Service Bulletins Tire Monitor System TPM Sensor Information INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 08-03-16-003 Date: May 12, 2008 Subject: Warranty Reduction - Transfer of Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensors to Replacement Wheels and Allowable TPM Sensor Replacements Models: 2000-2009 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2003-2009 HUMMER H2 2006-2009 HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7x with On-Wheel TPM Sensors TPM Sensor / Wheel Warranty Reviews During the last warranty review period it was noted that wheels being returned under the GM New Vehicle Warranty were being shipped back to General Motors with the TPM sensor still attached to the wheel. Return rates ran as high as 60% with the TPM sensors still attached. Operational TPM sensors should not be returned to GM and are to be transferred to replacement wheels if they become necessary. Important: Operational TPM Sensors that are returned under warranty to General Motors will be charged back to the dealer.Sensors have a 10 year /150,000 mile (240,000 km) battery life, and should be transferred if one or more wheels are replaced. TPM Valve Stem / Grommet (0-ring) Replacement When the TPM sensors are transferred to new wheels you should replace the component used to seal the TPM sensor stem to the wheel. On sensors with an aluminum stem and visible nut on the outside of the wheel a replacement grommet (0-ring) should be used to assure a proper seal. The sensor retaining nut (except Aveo) should be tightened to 7 N.m (62 lb in) for all vehicles except Pontiac Vibe (4.0 N.m (35.4 lb in)). Important: ^ DO NOT overtorque the retaining nut. Notice: ^ Factory installed TPM Sensors come with plastic aluminum or nickel-plated brass stem caps. These caps should not be changed. Chrome plated steel caps may cause corrosion of aluminum valve stems due to incompatibility of the metals. On current style sensors the entire rubber stem is replaceable. The service interval on the revised TPM sensor with replaceable stem is the same as for any other traditional valve stem. Replace the stem at the time of tire replacement sensor transfer or whenever air seepage is suspected at the valve stem. When replacing the valve stem tighten the screw to 1.3 N.m (11.5 lb in). For either style of TPM sensor see the service parts guide for the correct GM part numbers to order and use. Disclaimer Page 1763 7. Pressing the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool in the release cavity of the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and crimper in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (DOOR MODULE) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Side view of connector. View of top of connector. 1. Locate the assist lever and lock on the top of the connector. Page 696 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. 4. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front of the connector. Page 1738 TERMINAL REMOVAL Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors. 1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA) device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1). 3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 4. Gently pull the cable and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector. 5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal, refer to Terminal Repair. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3. Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector. REINSTALLING TERMINAL 1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly, refer to Wiring Repairs. 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3. Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) DELPHI CONNECTORS (WEATHER PACK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 8916 - JST connectors have JST in small letters on their connectors, similar to that above. The location of the logo will vary with the connector size and style. - Kostel has an "LK" with a circle around it. These connector are usually used as a transmissions connection and are currently use on some Cadillac vehicles. Page 7322 Utility/Van Zoning UTILITY/VAN ZONING Page 6869 Utility/Van Zoning UTILITY/VAN ZONING Page 6393 Page 4333 Coolant: Technical Service Bulletins Cooling System - Coolant Recycling Information Bulletin No.: 00-06-02-006D Date: August 15, 2006 INFORMATION Subject: Engine Coolant Recycling and Warranty Information Models: 2007 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2007 and Prior HUMMER Vehicles 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X Attention: Please address this bulletin to the Warranty Claims Administrator and the Service Manager. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to adjust the title and Include Warranty Information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 00-06-02-006C (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). Coolant Reimbursement Policy General Motors supports the use of recycled engine coolant for warranty repairs/service, providing a GM approved engine coolant recycling system is used. Recycled coolant will be reimbursed at the GMSPO dealer price for new coolant plus the appropriate mark-up. When coolant replacement is required during a warranty repair, it is crucial that only the relative amount of engine coolant concentrate be charged, not the total diluted volume. In other words: if you are using two gallons of pre-diluted (50:50) recycled engine coolant to service a vehicle, you may request reimbursement for one gallon of GM Goodwrench engine coolant concentrate at the dealer price plus the appropriate warranty parts handling allowance. Licensed Approved DEX-COOL(R) Providers Important: USE OF NON-APPROVED VIRGIN OR RECYCLED DEX-COOL(R) OR DEVIATIONS IN THE FORM OF ALTERNATE CHEMICALS OR ALTERATION OF EQUIPMENT, WILL VOID THE GM ENDORSEMENT, MAY DEGRADE COOLANT SYSTEM INTEGRITY AND PLACE THE COOLING SYSTEM WARRANTY UNDER JEOPARDY. Shown in Table 1 are the only current licensed and approved providers of DEX-COOL(R). Products that are advertised as "COMPATIBLE" or "RECOMMENDED" for use with DEX-COOL(R) have not been tested or approved by General Motors. Non-approved coolants may degrade the Page 2269 2. Use a small flat-bladed tool to release the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting the tool in the small recess on the side of the connector and pushing up until the TPA releases from the connector body. The TPA should raise just slightly. Do not try to remove the TPA. IMPORTANT: The TPA on this connector cannot be removed unless the terminals are removed first. The TPA will come out of the connector body, but only slightly. When the TPA is slightly raised the terminals can be removed. Using excessive force to remove the TPA with the terminals still in the connector will damage the connector. 3. Repeat the process for the other side of the connector. 4. Ensure that the TPA is in the proper position to remove the terminals. Page 2335 - Kostel - Molex - Sumitomo - Tyco/AMP - Yazaki Identifying the manufacturer of a connector is often difficult. When trying to determine the manufacturer of a connector, look for specific identifying marks that are unique to that connector supplier. Most of these identify marks are hard to find or see. Check the connector carefully and refer to the information below for pictures and descriptions of connector identification markings. - Most of AFLs connectors have EPC on their connector body. Some of the smaller connectors will not have any markings on them. - In some cases Bosch will actually be printed on the connector. If Bosch does not appear on the connector, look for the Bosch logo. The Bosch logo is a circle with a blunted arrow inside. This logo can appear anywhere on the connector and is often very small. Page 687 It is very important to use the correct test adapter when testing for proper terminal contact of fuses and relays in a bussed electrical center (BEC). Use J-35616-35 to test for proper terminal contact. Failure to use J-35616-35 can result in improper diagnosis of the BEC. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Separate the connector halves. 2. Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body. 3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J-38125 , test that the retention force is significantly different between a good terminal and a suspect terminal. Replace the female terminal in question. FLAT WIRE (DOCK AND LOCK) CONNECTORS There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock) connectors on the harness side or the component side. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Remove the component in question. 2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side of the connector as oil from your skin may be a source of contamination as well. 3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other imperfections that could cause poor terminal contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are uniform and free of damage or deformation. 4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the on the flat wire harness connector in order to test the circuit in question. CONTROL MODULE/COMPONENT VOLTAGE AND GROUNDS Poor voltage or ground connections can cause widely varying symptoms. Test all control module voltage supply circuits. Many vehicles have multiple circuits supplying voltage to a control module. Other components in the system may have separate voltage supply circuits that may also need to be tested. Inspect connections at the module/component connectors, fuses, and any intermediate connections between the voltage source and the module/component. A test lamp or a DMM may indicate that voltage is present, but neither tests the ability of the circuit to carry sufficient current. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Power Distribution Schematics. - Test all control module ground and system ground circuits. The control module may have multiple ground circuits. Other components in the system may have separate grounds that may also need to be tested. Inspect grounds for clean and tight connections at the grounding point. Inspect the connections at the component and in splice packs, where applicable. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Ground Distribution Schematics. TEMPERATURE SENSITIVITY - An intermittent condition may occur when a component/connection reaches normal operating temperature. The condition may occur only when the component/connection is cold, or only when the component/connection is hot. - Freeze Frame, Failure Records, Snapshot, or Vehicle Data Recorder data may help with this type of intermittent condition, where applicable. - If the intermittent is related to heat, review the data for a relationship with the following: High ambient temperatures - Underhood/engine generated heat - Circuit generated heat due to a poor connection, or high electrical load - Higher than normal load conditions, towing, etc. - If the intermittent is related to cold, review the data for the following: Low ambient temperatures-In extremely low temperatures, ice may form in a connection or component. Inspect for water intrusion. - The condition only occurs on a cold start. - The condition goes away when the vehicle warms up. - Information from the customer may help to determine if the trouble follows a pattern that is temperature related. - If temperature is suspected of causing an intermittent fault condition, attempt to duplicate the condition. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required. ELECTROMAGNETIC INTERFERENCE (EMI) AND ELECTRICAL NOISE Some electrical components/circuits are sensitive to electromagnetic interference (EMI) or other types of electrical noise. Inspect for the following conditions: A misrouted harness that is too close to high voltage/high current devices such as secondary ignition components, motors, generator etc-These components may induce electrical noise on a circuit that could interfere with normal circuit operation. - Electrical system interference caused by a malfunctioning relay, or a control module driven solenoid or switch-These conditions can cause a sharp electrical surge. Normally, the condition will occur when the malfunctioning component is operating. - Improper installation of non-factory or aftermarket add on accessories such as lights, 2-way radios, amplifiers, electric motors, remote starters, alarm systems, cell phones, etc-These accessories may lead to interference while in use, but do not fail when the accessories are not in use. - Test for an open diode across the A/C compressor clutch and for other open diodes. Some relays may contain a clamping diode. - The generator may be allowing AC noise into the electrical system. INCORRECT CONTROL MODULE - There are only a few situations where reprogramming a control module is appropriate: A new service control module is installed. Page 5405 Utility/Van Zoning UTILITY/VAN ZONING Page 2028 7. Pressing the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool in the release cavity of the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and crimper in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (DOOR MODULE) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Side view of connector. View of top of connector. 1. Locate the assist lever and lock on the top of the connector. Page 8127 to analyze the data during the time a vehicle condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a trigger point that you have determined. Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2 snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a first-in, first-out basis. If a third snapshot is taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost. Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types: Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice - Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200 frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not lost if the Scan Tool is powered down. The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis. The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected values by plotting 3 parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful, especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC. Testing for a Short to Voltage TESTING FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4. Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt, there is a short to voltage in the circuit. Testing for Continuity TESTING FOR CONTINUITY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6. Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit. 7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity. With a Test Lamp IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits. 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6. If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity. Testing for Electrical Intermittents TESTING FOR ELECTRICAL INTERMITTENTS Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment. - Testing for Short to Ground - Testing for Continuity - Testing for a Short to Voltage Page 6831 * The hose connections * The areas surrounding the connections Disconnect the CH-48027-2 (2) from the CH-48027-3 (4). 11. Disconnect the CH-48027-3 (4) from the fuel rail service port. 12. Remove the shop towel from around the fuel rail service port, and place in an approved gasoline container. 13. Install the fuel rail service port cap. 14. Install the engine cover, if required. 15. Tighten the fuel fill cap. Without CH-48027 Caution: Refer to Gasoline/Gasoline Vapors Caution. Caution: Remove the fuel tank cap and relieve the fuel system pressure before servicing the fuel system in order to reduce the risk of personal injury. After you relieve the fuel system pressure, a small amount of fuel may be released when servicing the fuel lines, the fuel injection pump, or the connections. In order to reduce the risk of personal injury, cover the fuel system components with a shop towel before disconnection. This will catch any fuel that may leak out. Place the towel in an approved container when the disconnection is complete. 1. Loosen the fuel fill cap in order to relieve the fuel tank vapor pressure. 2. Remove the engine cover, if required. 3. Remove the fuel rail service port cap. 4. Wrap a shop towel around the fuel rail service port and using a small flat bladed tool, depress (open) the fuel rail test port valve. 5. Remove the shop towel from around the fuel rail service port, and place in an approved gasoline container. 6. Install the fuel rail service port cap. 7. Install the engine cover, if required. 8. Tighten the fuel fill cap. Fuel Pressure Relief Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair Fuel Pressure Relief Fuel Pressure Relief Tools Required CH-48027 Digital Pressure Gage With CH-48027 Caution: Refer to Gasoline/Gasoline Vapors Caution. Caution: Remove the fuel tank cap and relieve the fuel system pressure before servicing the fuel system in order to reduce the risk of personal injury. After you relieve the fuel system pressure, a small amount of fuel may be released when servicing the fuel lines, the fuel injection pump, or the connections. In order to reduce the risk of personal injury, cover the fuel system components with a shop towel before disconnection. This will catch any fuel that may leak out. Place the towel in an approved container when the disconnection is complete. 1. Remove the engine cover, if required. 2. Loosen the fuel fill cap in order to relieve the fuel tank vapor pressure. 3. Remove the fuel rail service port cap. Caution: Wrap a shop towel around the fuel pressure connection in order to reduce the risk of fire and personal injury. The towel will absorb any fuel leakage that occurs during the connection of the fuel pressure gage. Place the towel in an approved container when the connection of the fuel pressure gage is complete. 4. Wrap a shop towel around the fuel rail service port. 5. Connect the CH-48027-3 (4) to the fuel rail service port. 6. Connect the CH-48027-2 (2) to the CH-48027-3 (4). 7. Place the hose on the CH-48027-2 (2) into an approved gasoline container. 8. Open the valve on the CH-48027-2 (2) in order to bleed any fuel from the fuel rail. 9. Close the valve on the CH-48027-2 (2). 10. Remove the hose on the CH-48027-2 (2) from the approved gasoline container. Important: If relieving the fuel pressure for the fuel pressure gage installation and removal, it is NOT necessary to proceed with the following steps. Notice: Clean all of the following areas before performing any disconnections in order to avoid possible contamination in the system: * The fuel pipe connections Page 4357 Page 1911 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert a small flat-blade tool in the slot below the front loaded terminal position assurance (TPA) and pry up. 3. Remove the TPA by pulling it out of the connector. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-553 (GM P/N 15315247) on a slight upward angle into the cavity below the terminal to be removed. Ensure that the pointed on the end of the tool is facing the bottom of the terminal and it stays in contact with the terminal until it stops on the plastic terminal retainer. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 238 9. The illustration shows a cutaway view of the connector to aid the technician in releasing the terminal retainer. 10. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Terminal Position Assurance Locks TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Tyco/Amp Connectors (CM 42-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (CM 42-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the connector body and pull the CPA out. The CPA is on the wire harness side of connector. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 1943 1. Connect the HO2S electrical connector (3). 2. Install the CPA retainer. Important: A special anti-seize compound is used on the HO2S threads. The compound consists of liquid graphite and glass beads. The graphite tends to burn away, but the glass beads remain, making the sensor easier to remove. New, or service replacement sensors already have the compound applied to the threads. If the sensor is removed from an exhaust component and if for any reason the sensor is to be reinstalled, the threads must have anti-seize compound applied before the reinstallation. 3. If reinstalling the old sensor, coat the threads with anti-seize compound GM P/N 12377953, or equivalent. Notice: Refer to Component Fastener Tightening Notice. Important: If the HO2S sensor is connected to the main wiring harness during installation. Rotate the HO2S sensor several turns counterclockwise before threading the HO2S sensor into the catalytic converter. This action of initially reverse winding of the pigtail wires will prevent a condition where the HO2S sensor pigtail wires become severely twisted or binding once the HO2S sensor is installed into the catalytic converter. 4. Install the HO2S (2). Tighten the sensor to 42 N.m (31 lb ft). 5. Lower the vehicle. Page 1786 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link). - The wire insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. 5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold them between thumb and forefinger. 7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place. - Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction. - Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip. 8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool closes.Ensure that no strands of wire are cut. 10. Crimp the splice on each end (2). Page 3715 Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial Force Variation (RFV) Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial Force Variation (RFV) INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 00-03-10-006F Date: May 04, 2010 Subject: Information on Tire Radial Force Variation (RFV) Models: 2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X 2000-2005 Saturn L Series 2003-2007 Saturn ION Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to considerably expand the available information on Radial Force Variation (RFV) and should be reviewed in whole. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 00-03-10-006E (Section 03 - Suspension). Important - Before measuring tires on equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700, the vehicle MUST be driven a minimum of 16 km (10 mi) to ensure removal of any flat-spotting. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 03-03-10-007E - Tire/Wheel Characteristics of GM Original Equipment Tires. - Equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700 MUST be calibrated prior to measuring tire/wheel assemblies for each vehicle. The purpose of this bulletin is to provide guidance to GM dealers when using tire force variation measurement equipment, such as the Hunter GSP9700. This type of equipment can be a valuable tool in diagnosing vehicle ride concerns. The most common ride concern involving tire radial force variation is highway speed shake on smooth roads. Tire related smooth road highway speed shake can be caused by three conditions: imbalance, out of round and tire force variation. These three conditions are not necessarily related. All three conditions must be addressed. Imbalance is normally addressed first, because it is the simpler of the three to correct. Off-vehicle, two plane dynamic wheel balancers are readily available and can accurately correct any imbalance. Balancer calibration and maintenance, proper attachment of the wheel to the balancer, and proper balance weights, are all factors required for a quality balance. However, a perfectly balanced tire/wheel assembly can still be "oval shaped" and cause a vibration. Before balancing, perform the following procedures. Tire and Wheel Diagnosis 1. Set the tire pressure to the placard values. 2. With the vehicle raised, ensure the wheels are centered on the hub by loosening all wheel nuts and hand-tightening all nuts first by hand while shaking the wheel, then torque to specifications using a torque wrench, NOT a torque stick. 3. Visually inspect the tires and the wheels. Inspect for evidence of the following conditions and correct as necessary: - Missing balance weights - Bent rim flange - Irregular tire wear - Incomplete bead seating - Tire irregularities (including pressure settings) - Mud/ice build-up in wheel - Stones in the tire tread - Remove any aftermarket wheels and/or tires and restore vehicle to original condition prior to diagnosing a smooth road shake condition. 4. Road test the vehicle using the Electronic Vibration Analyzer (EVA) essential tool. Drive for a sufficient distance on a known, smooth road surface to duplicate the condition. Determine if the vehicle is sensitive to brake apply. If the brakes are applied lightly and the pulsation felt in the steering wheel increases, refer to the Brakes section of the service manual that deals with brake-induced pulsation. If you can start to hear the vibration as a low boom noise (in addition to feeling it), but cannot see it, the vehicle likely has a first order (one pulse per propshaft revolution) driveline vibration. Driveline first order vibrations are high enough in frequency that most humans can start to hear them at highway speeds, but are too high to be able to be easily seen. These issues can be caused by driveline imbalance or misalignment. If the vehicle exhibits this low boom and the booming pulses in-and-out on a regular basis (like a throbbing), chances are good that the vehicle could have driveline vibration. This type Page 8194 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert a small flat-blade tool in the slot below the front loaded terminal position assurance (TPA) and pry up. 3. Remove the TPA by pulling it out of the connector. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-553 (GM P/N 15315247) on a slight upward angle into the cavity below the terminal to be removed. Ensure that the pointed on the end of the tool is facing the bottom of the terminal and it stays in contact with the terminal until it stops on the plastic terminal retainer. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Body Control Module (BCM) C1 Body Control Module (BCM) C1 Page 4886 Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Page 2064 4. Position the tool J 41364-A onto the park/neutral position switch. Ensure that the 2 slots on the switch where the manual shaft is inserted are lined up with the lower 2 tabs on the tool. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 5. Rotate the tool until the upper locator pin on the tool is lined up with the slot on the top of the switch. Tighten the bolts securing the switch to 25 N.m (18 lb ft). 6. Remove the J 41364-A from the switch. If installing a new switch, remove the positive assurance bracket at this time. 7. Connect the electrical connectors to the switch. 8. Install the transmission control lever to the manual shaft with the nut. Tighten the control lever nut to 25 N.m (18 lb ft). 9. Lower the vehicle. 10. Check the switch for proper operation. The engine must start in the P (Park) or N (Neutral) positions only. If proper operation of the switch can not be obtained, replace the switch. Page 5681 IMPORTANT: Ensure that the dress cover and connector body are both in the released position before reassembling. Failure to do so may cause damage to the connector and component. Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (0.64) BOSCH CONNECTORS (0.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While pressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock until the lever is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Pull the rubber boot that covers the wires back to expose the end of the connector dress cover. 4. Place the connector locking lever in the center of the connector. 5. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs that are on the wire end of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover and connector body and pry up. Page 1417 Page 5979 Release the lower wiredress cover locking tab. Release the upper wiredress cover locking tab. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. Page 2517 Page 3046 5. Install the compressor hose to the accumulator using new sealing washers. 6. Install the nut (1) to the accumulator. Tighten the nut to 16 N.m (12 lb ft). 7. Install the compressor hose to the A/C compressor using new sealing washers. 8. Install the compressor hose nut. Tighten the nut to 16 N.m (12 lb ft). 9. Install the washer bottle. 10. Evacuate and recharge the A/C system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 11. Leak test the fittings of the component using J39400-A. Page 974 Transmission Control Module (TCM), Engine Side (5.3L and 6.0L) Page 1769 5. While pushing the terminal forward, insert the J 38125-24 in the release cavity above the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (43-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Page 7802 4. Slide the dress cover forward and off of the connector. 5. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front and rear of the connector. Page 4166 Engine Oil Pressure: Testing and Inspection Oil Pressure Diagnosis and Testing Tools Required ^ EN-47971 Oil Pressure Gage Adapter ^ J 21867 Pressure Gage 1. With the vehicle on a level surface, run the vehicle for a few minutes, allow adequate drain down time, 2-3 minutes, and measure the oil level. 2. If required, add the recommended grade engine oil and fill the crankcase until the oil level measures full on the oil level indicator. 3. Run the engine briefly, 10-15 seconds, and verify low or no oil pressure on the vehicle gage or light. 4. Listen for a noisy valve train or a knocking noise. 5. Inspect for the following conditions: ^ Oil diluted by water or glycol antifreeze Refer to Coolant in Engine Oil. ^ Foamy oil, which may be caused by a cut or damaged oil pump screen O-ring seal 6. Remove the oil filter and install the EN-47971 (1). 7. Install the J 21867 (2), or equivalent to the EN-47971 (1). 8. Run the engine and measure the engine oil pressure. 9. Compare the readings to Engine Mechanical Specifications. 10. If the engine oil pressure is below specifications, inspect the engine for 1 or more of the following conditions: ^ Oil pump worn or dirty Refer to Oil Pump Cleaning and Inspection. ^ Oil pump-to-engine block bolts loose Refer to Oil Pump, Screen and Crankshaft Oil Deflector Installation. ^ Oil pump screen loose, plugged, or damaged ^ Oil pump screen O-ring seal missing or damaged ^ Oil filter tube loose or a leaking or damaged gasket ^ Malfunctioning oil pump pressure relief valve ^ Excessive bearing clearance ^ Cracked, porous, or restricted oil galleries ^ Oil gallery plugs missing or incorrectly installed Refer to Engine Block Plug Installation. ^ Improper operation of the active fuel management oil pressure relief valve Refer to Cylinder Deactivation (Active Fuel Management) Oil Pressure Relief Valve Diagnosis and Testing. Crankshaft Position Sensor Replacement Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Crankshaft Position Sensor Replacement Crankshaft Position Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure Important: Perform Crankshaft Position System Variation Learn whenever the crankshaft position (CKP) sensor is removed or replaced. 1. Remove the starter. 2. Disconnect the electrical connector (2) from the CKP sensor (1). 3. Clean the area around the CKP sensor before removal in order to avoid debris from entering the engine. 4. Remove the CKP sensor bolt. 5. Remove the CKP sensor. Installation Procedure Page 6075 3. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. View showing depressing of the lever lock release tab. Page 1512 11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the solder equipment. 12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. 13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to cover the first piece of tape. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE SLEEVES TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit IMPORTANT: Use only dura seal splice sleeves. Other splice sleeves may not protect the splice from moisture or provide a good electrical connection. Use duraseal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. Use duraseal splice sleeves where there is special requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire using duraseal splice sleeves. Page 4537 3. Use a small flat-bladed tool to gently pry off the dress cover by inserting the tool under the cover opposite the harness side and prying up. 4. Remove the cover. 5. Using a small flat-bladed tool, push on the side of the nose piece retainer while pushing the nose piece forward with your thumb. This will release the terminal position assurance (TPA). 6. Insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) into the corresponding terminal release cavity. The release cavities are the 2 center rows of cavities on one half of the connector. Page 8755 Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Heated Oxygen Sensor Replacement - Bank 1 Sensor 2 Heated Oxygen Sensor Replacement - Bank 1 Sensor 2 Removal Procedure 1. Raise and suitably support the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. Notice: Refer to Heated Oxygen and Oxygen Sensor Notice. 2. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) retainer. 3. Disconnect the heated oxygen sensor (HO2S) electrical connector. Notice: Refer to Excessive Force and Oxygen Sensor Notice. 4. Remove the HO2S (2). Installation Procedure Important: A special anti-seize compound is used on the HO2S threads. The compound consists of liquid graphite and glass beads. The graphite tends to burn away, but the glass beads remain, making the sensor easier to remove. New, or service replacement sensors already have the compound applied to the threads. If the sensor is removed from an exhaust component and if for any reason the sensor is to be reinstalled, the threads must have anti-seize compound applied before the reinstallation. Page 8874 Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair Park/Neutral Position Switch Replacement Tools Required J 41364-A Park/Neutral Switch Aligner Removal Procedure 1. Apply the parking brake. 2. Shift the transmission into neutral. 3. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 4. Remove the nut securing the transmission control lever to the manual shaft. 5. Remove the transmission control lever from the manual shaft. 6. Disconnect the electrical connectors from the switch. 7. Remove the bolts securing the park/neutral position switch to the transmission. 8. Remove the park/neutral position switch from the manual shaft. If the park/neutral position switch did not slide off the manual shaft, file the outer edge of the manual shaft in order to remove any burrs. Installation Procedure 1. Install the switch to the transmission manual shaft by aligning the switch hub flats with the manual shaft flats. 2. Slide the switch onto the transmission manual shaft until the switch mounting bracket contacts the mounting bosses on the transmission. Important: If a new switch is being installed, the switch will come with a positive assurance bracket. The positive assurance bracket aligns the new switch in it proper position for installation and the use of neutral position adjustment tool will not be necessary. 3. Install the switch to the transmission with 2 bolts finger tight. Page 5720 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Locations Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Locations Engine Controls Component Views Upper Left Side of the Engine 1 - Fuel Injector 1 2 - Evaporative Emission (EVAP) Canister Purge Solenoid 3 - Fuel Injector 3 4 Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor 5 - Fuel Injector 5 6 - Fuel Injector 7 7 - Engine 8 Ignition Coil 7 9 - Ignition Coil 5 10 - Ignition Coil Harness 11 - C109 12 - Ignition Coil 3 13 - Ignition Coil 1 Page 8331 Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Camshaft Position Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Remove the generator bracket assembly. 2. Remove the camshaft position sensor mounting bolts (1). 3. Remove the camshaft position sensor assembly (4, 5, 6) from the front cover (7). 4. Disconnect the camshaft position sensor jumper harness (2) and the engine harness (3) electrical connectors. 5. Remove the camshaft sensor assembly (4, 5, 6). 6. Disconnect camshaft position sensor (5) from the jumper harness (4). Installation Procedure 1. Reconnect the camshaft sensor (5) and the jumper harness (4). 2. Install the O-ring (6) on the camshaft sensor assembly (4, 5). 3. Reconnect the camshaft position sensor assembly (4, 5, 6) and the engine harness connector (3). Page 4430 2. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 1128 under pressure if the radiator cap or the surge tank cap is removed while the engine and radiator are still hot. 4. Remove the surge tank fill cap from the surge tank or the coolant pressure cap from the radiator. 5. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle in SI. 6. Place a clean drain pan under the radiator drain cock or under the lower radiator hose depending on the vehicle. Refer to Cooling System Draining and Filling in SI. 7. Loosen the radiator drain cock if equipped or use J 38185 clamp pliers and reposition the clamp on the lower radiator hose at the radiator. 8. Remove the end of the lower radiator hose from the radiator. 9. Drain the engine coolant sufficiently below the level of the ECT sensor. 10. Close the radiator drain cock or connect the lower radiator hose at the radiator. 11. Use the J 38185 clamp pliers to place the clamp into the original position on the hose. 12. Lower the vehicle. 13. Disconnect the wiring harness connector from the ECT sensor (2). 14. Remove the ECT sensor (1) from the front of the cylinder head. 15. Remove the corresponding size plug at the rear of the OTHER cylinder head. 16. Coat the threads of the ECT sensor with sealer. Use GM P/N 12346004 (Canadian P/N 10953480) or an equivalent. 17. Install the ECT sensor in the hole of the cylinder head where the plug was removed. Tighten Tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb ft). 18. Coat the threads of the plug with sealer. Use GM P/N 12346004 (Canadian P/N 10953480) or an equivalent. 19. Install the plug in the hole of the cylinder head where the ECT sensor was removed Tighten Tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb ft). Important Leave enough wire attached to the ECT sensor harness connector in order to create manageable splices that are at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splice. Page 1056 Passenger Seat Switches (With RPO Code V40) Page 2609 4. Slide the dress cover forward and off of the connector. 5. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front and rear of the connector. Page 2372 7. The illustration above identifies the entry canal where the terminal release tool will be inserted, and the terminal cavity. - Terminal (1) - Entry Canal (2) 8. Insert the J-38125-553 (15315247) tool into the entry canal and pry up on the terminal retainer. The terminal retainer is a small plastic piece on the top of the terminal. The terminal retainer must be held up while the terminal is pulled out of the connector. Page 3106 Disclaimer Page 14 Central Control Module: Service and Repair Communication Interface Module Replacement (TrailBlazer, Envoy, Rainier) Communication Interface Module Replacement (TrailBlazer, Envoy, Rainier) Removal Procedure Important: The vehicle communication interface module (VCIM) has a specific set of unique numbers that tie the module to each vehicle. These numbers, the 10-digit station identification and the 11-digit electronic serial number, are used by the National Cellular Network and OnStar(R) to identify the specific vehicle. Because these numbers are tied to the vehicle identification number of the vehicle, you must never exchange these parts with those of another vehicle. 1. Position the right rear seat bottom to a cargo position. 2. Remove the protective cover from the VCIM. 3. Remove the module from the upper bracket by releasing the retaining tab. 4. Remove the electrical connectors from the VCIM. 5. Remove the VCIM from the vehicle. Installation Procedure 1. If replacing the VCIM, record the 10-digit STID number, and the 11-digit ESN number from the labels on the new module. 2. Install the module to the upper bracket ensuring the retaining tab is fully seated. Page 4527 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the rear TPA from the connector. 7. IMPORTANT: The front TPA cannot be removed from the connector. Only move it to the release point. Use a small flat-blade tool to move the front TPA to the release position. 8. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 9. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Molex Connectors Drivetrain - Revised Rear Axle Fluid Level/Checking Fluid - Differential: Technical Service Bulletins Drivetrain - Revised Rear Axle Fluid Level/Checking Bulletin No.: 06-04-20-003 Date: October 10, 2006 SERVICE MANUAL UPDATE Subject: Revised Rear Axle Fluid Capacity and Fluid Level Checking Specification Models: 2005-2007 Buick Rainier 2005-2007 Chevrolet TrailBlazer Models 2005-2007 GMC Envoy Models This bulletin is being issued to revise the rear axle fluid capacity and fluid level checking specification in the Rear Axle sub-section of the Service Manual. Please replace the current information in the Service Manual with the following information. Page 3404 MOLEX CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. 2. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. Page 2522 1. Install the CKP sensor. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Install the CKP sensor bolt. Tighten the bolt to 25 N.m (18 lb ft). 3. Connect the electrical connector (2) to the CKP sensor (1). 4. Install the starter. Page 6389 6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias. Reference the appropriate service manual wiring schematic to obtain the correct diode installation position. 7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for the soldering equipment. 8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed. 9. IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode attachment points with tape. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape. Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable SPLICING TWISTED OR SHIELDED CABLE Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable. 1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splice is made. 3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire. Staggering the splices by 65 mm (2.5 in) is recommended. 4. IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical contact with the drain wire. Re-assemble the cable. Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape. - Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1). - Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire. - Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape. Page 4661 breakers are used. CIRCUIT BREAKER This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high current is removed. POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) CIRCUIT BREAKER This type greatly increases its resistance when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker will re-close within a second or 2. Circuit Protection - Fuses CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSES The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and examine the element in the fuse for an open (2). If not broken (1), also check for continuity using a DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one of equal current rating. Circuit Protection - Fusible Links CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSIBLE LINKS Page 8342 20. Extract a portion of the ECT sensor harness wiring and connector from the protective conduit. Cut off the ECT sensor harness connector and wiring. 21. Determine a routing path for the ECT sensor jumper harness wires so that they can be secured TO or WITHIN an existing protective conduit. Note This step is to set up and verify the length of wiring that is required before cutting. 22. Route the ECT sensor jumper wires and then enclose them in their own protective conduit in order to VERIFY the length that is required. 23. Cut the ECT sensor jumper wires to the appropriate length. Note Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splice or connector. 24. Splice the ECT sensor jumper wires to the ORIGINAL ECT HARNESS LOCATION using DuraSeal weatherproof splices. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves in SI. Note Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splice or connector. 25. Splice the ECT sensor jumper wires to the ECT SENSOR HARNESS CONNECTOR using DuraSeal weatherproof splices. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves in SI. 26. Connect the ECT sensor harness connector to the ECT sensor. 27. Secure the ECT sensor jumper wires that are in their own protective conduit TO or WITHIN the existing harness conduit using tie straps. Important You MUST run the engine at the specified RPM and until it reaches normal operating temperature and then allow it to idle as indicated in SI. The engine MUST then be allowed to cool down in order to top off the coolant level as needed. 28. Fill the cooling system to the proper level. Refer to Cooling System Draining and Filling in SI. 29. Pressure test the cooling system. Refer to Cooling System Leak Testing in SI. 30. Use a scan tool to clear any DTCs. Relocating the Engine Coolant Heater Cord Important For reference, the procedure and graphics that are shown are from a Chevrolet Silverado, but are similar for the other vehicles listed above. 1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Ask the customer where they would prefer the extension cord to exit from the engine compartment in order to determine the required extension cord length. 3. Obtain an extension cord with the following features: - 120 volt - 14/3 gauge - 15A capacity - Three prong - Polarized plug and receptacle - Chemical resistant - Grounded terminals - Designed for use in a cold outdoor environment - Outer jacket resistant to deterioration from moisture, abrasion and exposure to sunlight - Maximum length of 2.5-3 m (8-10 ft) 4. Release enough of the clips that retain the engine coolant heater cord to the vehicle to provide the necessary length for repositioning. 5. Apply dielectric grease to the electrical contacts of the heater cord receptacle and the extension cord plug to prevent corrosion. Use GM P/N 12345579 (in Canada, use P/N 10953481) or an equivalent. 6. Connect the heater cord receptacle to the extension cord plug and wipe OFF any excess grease. Page 5201 View of typical connector. View of connector in released position. 1. Locate the assist lever at the back of the connector. Move the assist lever to the rear position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the dress cover. Page 3721 to analyze the data during the time a vehicle condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a trigger point that you have determined. Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2 snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a first-in, first-out basis. If a third snapshot is taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost. Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types: Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice - Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200 frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not lost if the Scan Tool is powered down. The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis. The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected values by plotting 3 parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful, especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC. Testing for a Short to Voltage TESTING FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4. Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt, there is a short to voltage in the circuit. Testing for Continuity TESTING FOR CONTINUITY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6. Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit. 7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity. With a Test Lamp IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits. 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6. If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity. Testing for Electrical Intermittents TESTING FOR ELECTRICAL INTERMITTENTS Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment. - Testing for Short to Ground - Testing for Continuity - Testing for a Short to Voltage Page 1991 - Most Molex connectors will have the Molex logo on the dresscover of the connector. In some cases the connectors may have MX followed by another letter. The third letter indicates where the connector was made. A connector with MXD is a Molex connector made in Detroit. Sumitomo has a unique symbol on their connector and possibly a part number. The symbol is similar to that of a diamond lying on its side, similar to that shown. The logo could appear anywhere but the most common place is at the wire side of the housing. Tyco/AMP has many different and unique connector designs. Some may or may not have identifiable marks on them. Page 7550 If a wire is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm, etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except coaxial. - Do not use the DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent American wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 2792 Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Vehicle Speed Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Remove the harness connector. 2. Remove the bolt (2). 3. Remove the vehicle speed sensor (1). 4. Remove the O-ring seal (3). Installation Procedure 1. Install the O-ring seal (3) on the vehicle speed sensor (1). 2. Coat the O-ring seal (3) with a thin film of transmission fluid. 3. Install the vehicle speed sensor (1) into the transmission case. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 4. Install the bolt (2). Tighten the bolt to 11 N.m (97 lb in). 5. Connect the wiring harness electrical connector to the vehicle speed sensor. 6. Refill the fluid as required. Diagram Information and Instructions Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions Electrical Symbols Page 7778 - Yazaki has a wedge or arrow shape, similar to that shown. Delphi Connectors (Micro .64) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO.64) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from Micro 64 connectors. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. The lever lock may be located on the top or sides of the wire dress cover. Page 6026 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches, and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original. - The wires insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the possibility of fuel contact. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1). 5. Select the proper duraseal splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool. Refer to the Crimp and Seal Splice Table. 6. Place the duraseal splice sleeve in the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115) crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 7. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to hold the duraseal splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 8. Insert the wires into the duraseal splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel in order to prevent the wire from passing through the splice (3). 9. Close the handles of the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115), until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is applied to the splice sleeve. 10. Shrink the insulation around the splice. - Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. - Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Splicing Inline Harness Diodes SPLICING INLINE HARNESS DIODES Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure. 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode. 2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool. 5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode. Page 6925 4. Slide the dress cover forward and off of the connector. 5. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front and rear of the connector. Page 6212 - JST connectors have JST in small letters on their connectors, similar to that above. The location of the logo will vary with the connector size and style. - Kostel has an "LK" with a circle around it. These connector are usually used as a transmissions connection and are currently use on some Cadillac vehicles. Page 1888 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Kostal Connectors KOSTAL CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Locations Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Locations Engine Controls Component Views Accelerator and Brake Pedals 1 - Instrument Panel Harness 2 - Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor 3 - Accelerator Pedal 4 Brake Pedal 5 - Stop Lamp Switch Page 548 11. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 12. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 13. Center the high temperature SCT1 shrink tube over the DuraSeal splice sleeve. 14. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the high temperature heat shrink tubing. 15. Gradually move the heat from the center to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 16. Replace any reflective tape and clips that may have been remove during the repair. Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation REPAIRING DAMAGED WIRE INSULATION Wire Size Conversion Page 1482 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 6800 5. Remove paint and primer from the area surrounding the 10 mm (0.40 in) until bare metal is visible. Important The M6 conductive rivet stud as shown, can accommodate a panel thickness range of 0.7-4.2 mm (0.03-0.17 in). If there are layers of sheet metal, they should be touching without any air gaps to ensure a good ground. 6. Select a M6 conductive rivet stud. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. Note Use the GE-50317 rivet stud tool kit. 7. Place the M6 conductive rivet stud (1) in the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole. Assemble the rivet stud tool (2) with the groove and flare side facing the rivet stud, then the washer and the M6 nut (3). 8. Using a wrench on the rivet stud tool, and a socket on the M6 nut, secure the M6 conductive rivet stud. 9. Ensure the new rivet stud is securely fastened, WITHOUT ANY detectable movement. 10. Completely wrap the threads of the rivet stud with painters tape or equivalent. Page 8387 View of connector in released position. 4. Disconnect the connector from the component. 5. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Release the rear lower half of the wiredress cover. Locations Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Locations Hydraulic Brake Component Views Park Brake Switch 1 - Park Brake Lever Assembly 2 - Park Brake Switch Page 3304 Release the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the blue locking tabs on both ends of the connector. Gently slide the TPA up to the released position on both ends. 6. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-13A (GM P/N 12031876-1) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. Page 6414 IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals. Front probe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the connector. IMPORTANT: When probing female 0.64 terminals, it is important to use the correct adapter. There have been some revisions to the test adapter for 0.64 terminals. The proper adapter for 0.64 terminals is the J 35616-64B which has a gold terminal and a black wire between the base and tip. Failure to use the proper test adapter may result in damage to the terminal being tested and improper diagnosis. NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Page 6282 Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair Mass Airflow Sensor/Intake Air Temperature Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure Important: Use care when handling the mass air flow (MAF)/intake air temperature (IAT) sensor. Do not dent, puncture, or otherwise damage the honeycell located at the air inlet end of the MAF/IAT. Do not touch the sensing elements or allow anything including cleaning solvents and lubricants to come in contact with them. Use a small amount of a non-silicone based lubricant, on the air duct only, to aid in installation. 1. Disconnect the MAF/IAT sensor electrical connector. 2. Loosen the clamps at the MAF/IAT sensor and the throttle body. 3. Remove the air cleaner outlet duct bolt. 4. Remove the air cleaner outlet duct. 5. Loosen the clamp attaching the MAF/IAT sensor to the air cleaner housing. 6. Remove the MAF/IAT sensor from the air cleaner housing. Installation Procedure Important: The embossed arrow on the MAF/IAT sensor indicates the proper air flow direction. The arrow must point toward the engine. Page 2857 Alignment: Service and Repair Front Toe Adjustment Front Toe Adjustment 1. Loosen the jam nut on the outer tie rod (2). Notice: Care must be taken that the boots are not twisted when rotating the inner tie rods, or damage to the boots may result. 2. Rotate the inner tie rod (1) to the required toe specification setting. Refer to Wheel Alignment Specifications. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 3. Tighten the jam nut on the outer tie rod. Tighten the outer tie rod jam nut to 75 N.m (55 lb ft). 4. Check the toe setting after tightening. 5. Re-adjust the toe setting if necessary. Page 6068 Refer to the following table as a guide in selecting the correct test adapter for front probing connectors: Backprobe IMPORTANT: Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures. - Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector. - Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large of a test probe. - After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected, test for proper terminal contact. Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the connector. Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure SCAN TOOL SNAPSHOT PROCEDURE Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used Page 7126 20. Extract a portion of the ECT sensor harness wiring and connector from the protective conduit. Cut off the ECT sensor harness connector and wiring. 21. Determine a routing path for the ECT sensor jumper harness wires so that they can be secured TO or WITHIN an existing protective conduit. Note This step is to set up and verify the length of wiring that is required before cutting. 22. Route the ECT sensor jumper wires and then enclose them in their own protective conduit in order to VERIFY the length that is required. 23. Cut the ECT sensor jumper wires to the appropriate length. Note Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splice or connector. 24. Splice the ECT sensor jumper wires to the ORIGINAL ECT HARNESS LOCATION using DuraSeal weatherproof splices. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves in SI. Note Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splice or connector. 25. Splice the ECT sensor jumper wires to the ECT SENSOR HARNESS CONNECTOR using DuraSeal weatherproof splices. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves in SI. 26. Connect the ECT sensor harness connector to the ECT sensor. 27. Secure the ECT sensor jumper wires that are in their own protective conduit TO or WITHIN the existing harness conduit using tie straps. Important You MUST run the engine at the specified RPM and until it reaches normal operating temperature and then allow it to idle as indicated in SI. The engine MUST then be allowed to cool down in order to top off the coolant level as needed. 28. Fill the cooling system to the proper level. Refer to Cooling System Draining and Filling in SI. 29. Pressure test the cooling system. Refer to Cooling System Leak Testing in SI. 30. Use a scan tool to clear any DTCs. Relocating the Engine Coolant Heater Cord Important For reference, the procedure and graphics that are shown are from a Chevrolet Silverado, but are similar for the other vehicles listed above. 1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Ask the customer where they would prefer the extension cord to exit from the engine compartment in order to determine the required extension cord length. 3. Obtain an extension cord with the following features: - 120 volt - 14/3 gauge - 15A capacity - Three prong - Polarized plug and receptacle - Chemical resistant - Grounded terminals - Designed for use in a cold outdoor environment - Outer jacket resistant to deterioration from moisture, abrasion and exposure to sunlight - Maximum length of 2.5-3 m (8-10 ft) 4. Release enough of the clips that retain the engine coolant heater cord to the vehicle to provide the necessary length for repositioning. 5. Apply dielectric grease to the electrical contacts of the heater cord receptacle and the extension cord plug to prevent corrosion. Use GM P/N 12345579 (in Canada, use P/N 10953481) or an equivalent. 6. Connect the heater cord receptacle to the extension cord plug and wipe OFF any excess grease. Page 2193 Page 6913 The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors. 1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position. 4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool J 38125-10A (GM P/N 12014012-1) into the front (mating end) of the connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal through the back of the connector (2). IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector. 6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. 7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily. 10. Perform system check. Delphi Connectors (12 Way) DELPHI CONNECTORS (12-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. Page 6042 1. Connect the HO2S electrical connector (3). 2. Install the CPA retainer. Important: A special anti-seize compound is used on the HO2S threads. The compound consists of liquid graphite and glass beads. The graphite tends to burn away, but the glass beads remain, making the sensor easier to remove. New, or service replacement sensors already have the compound applied to the threads. If the sensor is removed from an exhaust component and if for any reason the sensor is to be reinstalled, the threads must have anti-seize compound applied before the reinstallation. 3. If reinstalling the old sensor, coat the threads with anti-seize compound GM P/N 12377953, or equivalent. Notice: Refer to Component Fastener Tightening Notice. Important: If the HO2S sensor is connected to the main wiring harness during installation. Rotate the HO2S sensor several turns counterclockwise before threading the HO2S sensor into the catalytic converter. This action of initially reverse winding of the pigtail wires will prevent a condition where the HO2S sensor pigtail wires become severely twisted or binding once the HO2S sensor is installed into the catalytic converter. 4. Install the HO2S (2). Tighten the sensor to 42 N.m (31 lb ft). 5. Lower the vehicle. Page 2363 4. Slide the dress cover forward and off of the connector. 5. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front and rear of the connector. Page 2136 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully raise the TPA on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA cannot be removed from the connector while there are terminals present in the connector body. View of the TPA when removed from the connector body. 4. Use the J 38125-12A tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the left side of the terminal release cavity as shown in the graphic. Use the tool to move the terminal release to the right with a gentle prying motion. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 741 9. The illustration shows a cutaway view of the connector to aid the technician in releasing the terminal retainer. 10. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Terminal Position Assurance Locks TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Tyco/Amp Connectors (CM 42-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (CM 42-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the connector body and pull the CPA out. The CPA is on the wire harness side of connector. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 395 The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors. 1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position. 4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool J 38125-10A (GM P/N 12014012-1) into the front (mating end) of the connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal through the back of the connector (2). IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector. 6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. 7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily. 10. Perform system check. Delphi Connectors (12 Way) DELPHI CONNECTORS (12-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. Page 7752 vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide variety of actions, including: - Wiggling the harness - Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting - Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector - Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation - Relocating a harness or wires All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. Another option is, with the component commanded ON and OFF by the scan tool, move related connectors and wiring and observe the component operation. With the engine running, move related connectors and wiring while monitoring engine operation. If harness or connector movement affects the data displayed, component/system operation, or engine operation, inspect and repair the harness/connections as necessary. You may need to load the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these cases you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide good results as well. There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions, along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the circuit to these kinds of conditions. SALT WATER SPRAY Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture. Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5 percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously. HIGH TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070. Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault condition. The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis. This option does not allow for the same control, however. LOW TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect. If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to -18°C (0°F) from one end and +71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized cooling needs. Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or components in an effort to duplicate the concern. DUPLICATING FAILURE CONDITIONS - If none of the previous tests are successful, attempt to duplicate and/or capture the failure conditions. Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, where applicable, contains the conditions that were present when the DTC set. 1. Review and record Freeze Frame/Failure Records data. 2. Clear the DTCs using the scan tool. 3. Turn the key to OFF and wait 15 seconds. 4. Operate the vehicle under the same conditions that were noted in Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, as closely as possible. The vehicle must also be operating within the Conditions for Running the DTC. Refer to Conditions for Running the DTC in the supporting text if a DTC is being diagnosed. 5. Monitor DTC Status for the DTC being tested. The scan tool will indicate Ran, when the enabling conditions have been satisfied long enough for the DTC to run. The scan tool will also indicate whether the DTC passed or failed. - An alternate method is to drive the vehicle with the DMM connected to a suspected circuit. An abnormal reading on the DMM when the concern occurs, may help you locate the concern. Measuring Frequency Page 6231 REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. The release tab is located on the top of the wiredress cover. View of connector in released position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Page 7416 6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias. Reference the appropriate service manual wiring schematic to obtain the correct diode installation position. 7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for the soldering equipment. 8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed. 9. IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode attachment points with tape. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape. Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable SPLICING TWISTED OR SHIELDED CABLE Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable. 1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splice is made. 3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire. Staggering the splices by 65 mm (2.5 in) is recommended. 4. IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical contact with the drain wire. Re-assemble the cable. Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape. - Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1). - Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire. - Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape. Service Precautions Vehicle Lifting: Service Precautions Vehicle Lifting Caution Caution: To avoid any vehicle damage, serious personal injury or death when major components are removed from the vehicle and the vehicle is supported by a hoist, support the vehicle with jack stands at the opposite end from which the components are being removed and strap the vehicle to the hoist. Page 7223 6. Gently pry the plastic terminal retainer down and carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (16-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, pull the two connector halves apart. Page 6247 7. The illustration above identifies the entry canal where the terminal release tool will be inserted, and the terminal cavity. - Terminal (1) - Entry Canal (2) 8. Insert the J-38125-553 (15315247) tool into the entry canal and pry up on the terminal retainer. The terminal retainer is a small plastic piece on the top of the terminal. The terminal retainer must be held up while the terminal is pulled out of the connector. Page 6949 View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. 4. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers CIRCUIT PROTECTION - CIRCUIT BREAKERS A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types of circuit Page 5585 9. The illustration shows a cutaway view of the connector to aid the technician in releasing the terminal retainer. 10. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Terminal Position Assurance Locks TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Tyco/Amp Connectors (CM 42-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (CM 42-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the connector body and pull the CPA out. The CPA is on the wire harness side of connector. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 8965 2. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully push the terminal position assurance (TPA) towards the face of the connector on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA is fragile and may break if not done carefully. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. 3. Use the J 38125-215 tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 4449 If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs SIR/SRS WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS, and the wiring components, such as connectors and terminals. IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system terminals. Use either an SIR/SRS pigtail or a terminated lead from the SIR Repair Kit Tray. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves, in order to repair the SIR/SRS wiring - A special crimping tool - A heat torch - An instruction manual The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides the necessary low resistance contact integrity for these sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors SIR/SRS CONNECTOR REPAIR (PLASTIC BODY AND TERMINAL METAL PIN) The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made with a special plating. This plating provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. Use the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit for repairing SIR/SRS terminals and connectors. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the repair kit. The J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit contains: Various terminated leads for sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) terminal replacement - Various connector positive assurance (CPA) locks for SIR/SRS connectors - Base of steering column pigtail connectors part number 12085514 - Yellow vinyl electrical tape Pigtail repair packs are available for SIR/SRS connectors with eight or less terminals. Only the connector body is available for connectors with more than eight terminals. The terminated leads in the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit can be used to replace damaged terminals when replacing the connector body. SIR/SRS COMPONENT WIRE PIGTAIL REPAIR IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails. A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device, not by a connector. If a wiring pigtail is damaged, you must replace the entire component, with pigtail. The inflatable restraint steering wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component. SIR/SRS WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 6479 2. Use a small flat-bladed tool to release the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting the tool in the small recess on the side of the connector and pushing up until the TPA releases from the connector body. The TPA should raise just slightly. Do not try to remove the TPA. IMPORTANT: The TPA on this connector cannot be removed unless the terminals are removed first. The TPA will come out of the connector body, but only slightly. When the TPA is slightly raised the terminals can be removed. Using excessive force to remove the TPA with the terminals still in the connector will damage the connector. 3. Repeat the process for the other side of the connector. 4. Ensure that the TPA is in the proper position to remove the terminals. Page 1319 - A control module from another vehicle is installed. - Revised software/calibration files have been released for this vehicle. - IMPORTANT: DO NOT re-program the control module with the SAME software/calibration files that are already present in the control module. This is not an effective repair for any type of concern. Verify that the control module contains the correct software/calibration. If incorrect programming is found, reprogram the control module with the most current software/calibration. Refer to Control Module References for replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Testing for Short to Ground TESTING FOR SHORT TO GROUND NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 4. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit. With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is a short to ground in the circuit. Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2. Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). - When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. - If the DMM does not display voltage 4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is shorted. Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A DIGITAL MULTIMETER NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the powertrain control module (PCM), should only be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200 Digital Multimeter (DMM). The J 39200 instruction manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminage even though voltage is present. The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity. IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading. Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the measurement. Page 3345 Cooling System - DEX-COOL(R) Coolant Leak Detection Dye Coolant: Technical Service Bulletins Cooling System - DEX-COOL(R) Coolant Leak Detection Dye Bulletin No.: 05-06-02-002B Date: January 18, 2008 INFORMATION Subject: DEX-COOL(R) Coolant - New Leak Detection Dye J 46366 - Replaces J 29545-6 Models: 1996-2008 GM Passenger Cars and Light/Medium Duty Trucks* (including Saturn) 1997-2008 Isuzu T-Series Medium Duty Tilt Cab Models Built in Janesville and Flint 1999-2008 Isuzu N-Series Medium Duty Commercial Models with 5.7L or 6.0L Gas Engine 2003-2008 HUMMER H2 2006-2008 HUMMER H3 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X *EXCLUDING 2006 and Prior Chevrolet Aveo, Epica, Optra, Vivant and Pontiac Matiz, Wave Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to include additional model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 05-06-02-002A (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). Leak detection dye P/N 12378563 (J 29545-6) (in Canada P/N 88900915) may cause DEX-COOL(R) coolant to appear green in a black vessel making it appear to be conventional (green) coolant. This may cause a technician to add conventional coolant to a low DEX-COOL(R) system thus contaminating it. The green DEX-COOL(R) appearance is caused by the color of the leak detection dye which alters the color of the DEX-COOL(R) coolant. A new leak detection dye P/N 89022219 (J 46366) (in Canada P/N 89022220) has been released that does not alter the appearance of the DEX-COOL(R) coolant. When adding the new leak detection dye the color of the DEX-COOL(R) coolant will not change. For detecting leaks on any system that uses DEX-COOL(R) leak detection dye P/N 89022219 (in Canada P/N 89022220) should be used. The new leak detection dye can be used with both conventional and DEX-COOL(R) coolant. Disclaimer Page 6584 7. The illustration above identifies the entry canal where the terminal release tool will be inserted, and the terminal cavity. - Terminal (1) - Entry Canal (2) 8. Insert the J-38125-553 (15315247) tool into the entry canal and pry up on the terminal retainer. The terminal retainer is a small plastic piece on the top of the terminal. The terminal retainer must be held up while the terminal is pulled out of the connector. Page 276 Front Passenger Door Module (FPDM) C1 Page 2014 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Kostal Connectors KOSTAL CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 1359 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully raise the TPA on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA cannot be removed from the connector while there are terminals present in the connector body. View of the TPA when removed from the connector body. 4. Use the J 38125-12A tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the left side of the terminal release cavity as shown in the graphic. Use the tool to move the terminal release to the right with a gentle prying motion. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 5322 7. Apply pressure and gently rock the cover until one locking leg is unseated. 8. Continue to apply pressure and rock the cover until the second locking leg is unseated. Repeat procedure for the other side of the dress cover and remove the cover. 9. Use J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) to gently lift the terminal retaining tab while gently pulling the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 10. If the terminal is severely bent or damaged, it may be possible on some connectors to push the wire out of the front of the connector instead of Page 6920 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. JST Connectors JST CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, remove the connector from the component. Page 2142 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. 4. Remove the dress cover by using a flat bladed tool to release the dress cover locking tabs and lift up on the dress cover. 5. Cut the tie wrap that holds the wires to the connector body. Page 3636 *This product is currently available from 3M. To obtain information for your local retail location please call 3M at 1-888-364-3577. **This product is currently available from Meguiars (Canada). To obtain information for your local retail location please call Meguiars at 1-800-347-5700 or at www.meguiarscanada.com. ^ This product is currently available from Tri-Peek International. To obtain information for your local retail location please call Tri-Peek at 1-877-615-4272 or at www.tripeek.com. Disclaimer Page 554 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches, and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original. - The wires insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the possibility of fuel contact. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1). 5. Select the proper duraseal splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool. Refer to the Crimp and Seal Splice Table. 6. Place the duraseal splice sleeve in the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115) crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 7. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to hold the duraseal splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 8. Insert the wires into the duraseal splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel in order to prevent the wire from passing through the splice (3). 9. Close the handles of the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115), until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is applied to the splice sleeve. 10. Shrink the insulation around the splice. - Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. - Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Splicing Inline Harness Diodes SPLICING INLINE HARNESS DIODES Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure. 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode. 2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool. 5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode. Service Precautions Vehicle Lifting: Service Precautions Vehicle Lifting Caution Caution: To avoid any vehicle damage, serious personal injury or death when major components are removed from the vehicle and the vehicle is supported by a hoist, support the vehicle with jack stands at the opposite end from which the components are being removed and strap the vehicle to the hoist. Page 6179 Page 7217 3. Ensure that the terminal release tang access panel is in the correct location to access the terminals. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) into the terminal release tang access slot located behind the access panel of the connector and press down on the terminal while carefully pulling the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Tyco/AMP Connectors (0.25 Cap) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (025 CAP) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component by pressing down on the connector position assurance (CPA). Locations Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Locations Engine Controls Component Views Accelerator and Brake Pedals 1 - Instrument Panel Harness 2 - Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor 3 - Accelerator Pedal 4 Brake Pedal 5 - Stop Lamp Switch Page 7948 Important The following information MUST be documented on the repair order. Failure to do so may result in a chargeback. - Customer vehicle condition. - Was a Service Lamp or Service Message illuminated? If yes, specify which Service Lamp or Service Message. - Was a DTC(s) set? If yes, specify which DTC(s) were set. - After following the procedure contained within this bulletin, could the condition be duplicated? ‹› If the condition was not duplicated, then document the affected module/component connector name and number on the repair order. - If the condition was duplicated after the procedure contained within this bulletin was followed, and additional diagnosis led to the replacement of a module or component, the SI Document ID Number MUST be written on the repair order. Parts Information Alternate Distributor For All of North America Note NyoGel(R) 760G Lubricant* is equivalent to GMSPO P/N 12377900, and P/N 10953529 (Canada), specified for use to correct the condition in this bulletin. *We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may be available from other sources. Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to: Warranty Information (Saab Models) Page 7436 8. Install the ECM/TCM cover. 9. Ensure the ECM/TCM cover retainers (1) are fully engaged to the ECM/TCM bracket. 10. Connect the cooling fan electrical connector. 11. Connect the negative battery cable. 12. If the ECM was replaced the replacement ECM must be programmed. Refer to Control Module References. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Page 6909 7. Apply pressure and gently rock the cover until one locking leg is unseated. 8. Continue to apply pressure and rock the cover until the second locking leg is unseated. Repeat procedure for the other side of the dress cover and remove the cover. 9. Use J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) to gently lift the terminal retaining tab while gently pulling the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 10. If the terminal is severely bent or damaged, it may be possible on some connectors to push the wire out of the front of the connector instead of Page 8742 Page 6016 If a wire is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm, etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except coaxial. - Do not use the DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent American wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 7082 View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. View of the release tool being used for the smaller terminals. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (2-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 4098 Allow at least a two hour soak time between engine OFF and start up when evaluating the tick noise. 2. Start the engine and evaluate the valve lifter tick noise. ‹› If the valve lifter tick noise is still present, replace all 16 valve lifters. Refer to Valve Lifter Replacement in SI. Parts Information Note A V8 AFM engine requires 8 AFM lifters and 8 non-AFM lifters for a total of 16 lifters. Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use: Warranty Information (Saab Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 8252 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. 4. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front of the connector. Page 6143 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Start in the middle and gradually move the heat barrel to the open ends of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Heated Oxygen Sensor Wiring Repairs HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being obstructed. If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. - Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks, etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire. - Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance. - To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector. Page 5571 2. Locate the two indents of the terminal position assurance (TPA) located on the bottom of the connector body. Page 3266 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert terminal into the appropriate terminal holder until it hits bottom and stops. The correct terminal holder is determined by the wire size. Also ensure that the terminals wings are pointing towards the former on the tool and the release locator. 5. Insert the stripped cable into the terminal. Insulation should be visible on both sides of the terminal insulation wings. 6. Compress the handles until the ratchet automatically releases. 7. Place the terminal into the appropriate cavity and assemble the connector. Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO-PACK 100W) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W connectors. These connectors are very similar but use different terminals and have some minor physical differences also. Page 5233 11. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 12. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 13. Center the high temperature SCT1 shrink tube over the DuraSeal splice sleeve. 14. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the high temperature heat shrink tubing. 15. Gradually move the heat from the center to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 16. Replace any reflective tape and clips that may have been remove during the repair. Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation REPAIRING DAMAGED WIRE INSULATION Wire Size Conversion Page 7376 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Kostal Connectors KOSTAL CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 8241 to analyze the data during the time a vehicle condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a trigger point that you have determined. Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2 snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a first-in, first-out basis. If a third snapshot is taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost. Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types: Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice - Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200 frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not lost if the Scan Tool is powered down. The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis. The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected values by plotting 3 parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful, especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC. Testing for a Short to Voltage TESTING FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4. Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt, there is a short to voltage in the circuit. Testing for Continuity TESTING FOR CONTINUITY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6. Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit. 7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity. With a Test Lamp IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits. 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6. If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity. Testing for Electrical Intermittents TESTING FOR ELECTRICAL INTERMITTENTS Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment. - Testing for Short to Ground - Testing for Continuity - Testing for a Short to Voltage Page 465 Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Page 2336 - In some cases Delphi will actually be printed on the connector. If Delphi is not printed on the connector, look for PED. In both cases there is no specific orientation for Delphi or PED and they can appear anywhere on the connector. - FCI connectors may have the FCI logo on their connectors. The logo is the letters FCI with an "A" above it. - JAE connector have JAE in small letters on their connectors. Page 8798 Connector Anatomy Connector Repairs contains a list of all connector repairs. The connector repairs are listed by the connector manufacturer and then by connector type. If the technician cannot identify the manufacturer of the connector, refer to Identifying Connectors below. Knowing the connector manufacturer will assist in finding the correct connector repair from the following list: - Connector Position Assurance Locks - Terminal Position Assurance Locks - Bosch Connectors (0.64) Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) Bosch Connectors (BSK) Bosch Connectors (ECM) - Delphi Connectors (Micro.64) Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) Delphi Connectors (12-Way) - Tyco/AMP Connectors (CM 42-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) Tyco/AMP Connectors (025 Cap) Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) - Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) - Repairing Connector Terminals IDENTIFYING CONNECTORS Knowing the connector manufacturer is helpful when trying to locating the correct connector repair procedure. There are many different connector designs used on GM vehicles and it is sometimes difficult to identify the connector manufacturer. The information in this document should help with the identification of connector manufactures. The following connector manufacturers make most of the connectors found in GM vehicles: AFL/EPC (Alcoa Fujikura Ltd./Engineered Plastics Components) - Bosch - Delphi - FCI (Framatome Connectors International) - JAE (Japan Aviation Electronics) - JST (Japan Solderless Terminals) Page 3303 5. While pushing the terminal forward, insert the J 38125-24 in the release cavity above the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (43-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Page 7838 11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the solder equipment. 12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. 13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to cover the first piece of tape. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE SLEEVES TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit IMPORTANT: Use only dura seal splice sleeves. Other splice sleeves may not protect the splice from moisture or provide a good electrical connection. Use duraseal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. Use duraseal splice sleeves where there is special requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire using duraseal splice sleeves. Page 362 If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200 DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J 39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected. IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J 39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and maximum (MAX) values measured. 1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of a suspected circuit to the other. 2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J 39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep). IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value in order to record the full change. 5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling the connections or the wiring, test driving, or performing other operations. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions. 6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9. Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary. - If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist. Testing for Intermittent Conditions and Poor Connections TESTING FOR INTERMITTENT CONDITIONS AND POOR CONNECTIONS TOOLS REQUIRED - J 35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit - J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit When the condition is not currently present, but is indicated in DTC history, the cause may be intermittent. An intermittent may also be the cause when there is a customer complaint, but the symptom cannot be duplicated. Refer to the Symptom Table of the system that is suspect of causing the condition before trying to locate an intermittent condition. Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the following items: Wiring broken inside the insulation - Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector - Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself, and corrosion in the wire to terminal contact area, etc. - Pierced or damaged insulation can allow moisture to enter the wiring causing corrosion. The conductor can corrode inside the insulation, with little visible evidence. Look for swollen and stiff sections of wire in the suspect circuits. - Wiring which has been pinched, cut, or its insulation rubbed through may cause an intermittent open or short as the bare area touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle. - Wiring that comes in contact with hot or exhaust components - Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required, in order to verify the customer concern. - Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. - Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis and Vehicle Data Recorder operation. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any inline connectors before replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation. Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination, usually in the underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit. Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper adapter. Always use the J 35616 when probing connectors. Other causes of terminal deformation are improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit. TESTING FOR PROPER TERMINAL CONTACT IN BUSSED ELECTRICAL CENTERS (BEC) Page 575 HVAC Control Module C2 HVAC Control Module - Auxiliary Steering Wheel Speed/Position Sensor Page 2248 2. Locate the two indents of the terminal position assurance (TPA) located on the bottom of the connector body. Page 6609 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the DuraSeal splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of a connector. CPAs are used in all SIR System connectors and also in some connectors of other systems. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals of a connection. TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE CLIPS IMPORTANT: When making a splice in an area that may be exposed to moisture use a crimp and seal splice sleeve instead of a Splice Clip. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. Page 5756 Page 8905 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (BSK) BOSCH CONNECTORS (BSK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 3. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 4. Insert the J 38125-561 tool into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 5. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is Page 5714 4. Slide the dress cover forward and off of the connector. 5. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front and rear of the connector. Page 6894 11. Insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) into the 2 triangular cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 12. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE 1. Prior to installation the terminal must be aligned so the (1) coding lugs align with the (2) coding grooves on the connector. 2. Once the terminal is aligned, slide the terminal into the cavity until the retainer has engaged in the cavity of the connector. 3. Slide the TPA in the connector body and seat it using a small flat bladed tool. The TPA is seated when it is flush with the contact housing. 4. Secure the wires to the connector body using a tie wrap and replace the dress cover and grommet. Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) BOSCH CONNECTORS (2.8 JPT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Pull out the slider on the connector position assurance (CPA) until it is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 6897 - Kostel - Molex - Sumitomo - Tyco/AMP - Yazaki Identifying the manufacturer of a connector is often difficult. When trying to determine the manufacturer of a connector, look for specific identifying marks that are unique to that connector supplier. Most of these identify marks are hard to find or see. Check the connector carefully and refer to the information below for pictures and descriptions of connector identification markings. - Most of AFLs connectors have EPC on their connector body. Some of the smaller connectors will not have any markings on them. - In some cases Bosch will actually be printed on the connector. If Bosch does not appear on the connector, look for the Bosch logo. The Bosch logo is a circle with a blunted arrow inside. This logo can appear anywhere on the connector and is often very small. Page 6229 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the TPA. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the nose piece. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. Page 1467 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the TPA. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the nose piece. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. Page 8341 under pressure if the radiator cap or the surge tank cap is removed while the engine and radiator are still hot. 4. Remove the surge tank fill cap from the surge tank or the coolant pressure cap from the radiator. 5. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle in SI. 6. Place a clean drain pan under the radiator drain cock or under the lower radiator hose depending on the vehicle. Refer to Cooling System Draining and Filling in SI. 7. Loosen the radiator drain cock if equipped or use J 38185 clamp pliers and reposition the clamp on the lower radiator hose at the radiator. 8. Remove the end of the lower radiator hose from the radiator. 9. Drain the engine coolant sufficiently below the level of the ECT sensor. 10. Close the radiator drain cock or connect the lower radiator hose at the radiator. 11. Use the J 38185 clamp pliers to place the clamp into the original position on the hose. 12. Lower the vehicle. 13. Disconnect the wiring harness connector from the ECT sensor (2). 14. Remove the ECT sensor (1) from the front of the cylinder head. 15. Remove the corresponding size plug at the rear of the OTHER cylinder head. 16. Coat the threads of the ECT sensor with sealer. Use GM P/N 12346004 (Canadian P/N 10953480) or an equivalent. 17. Install the ECT sensor in the hole of the cylinder head where the plug was removed. Tighten Tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb ft). 18. Coat the threads of the plug with sealer. Use GM P/N 12346004 (Canadian P/N 10953480) or an equivalent. 19. Install the plug in the hole of the cylinder head where the ECT sensor was removed Tighten Tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb ft). Important Leave enough wire attached to the ECT sensor harness connector in order to create manageable splices that are at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splice. Page 1234 Brake Light Switch: Service and Repair STOP LAMP SWITCH REPLACEMENT REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Remove the left sound insulator. 2. Remove the pushrod retainer (3) from the brake pedal pin (4). 3. Remove the stop lamp switch (1) and the pushrod (2) from the brake pedal pin (4). 4. Disconnect the stop lamp switch (1) electrical connector. 5. Remove the stop lamp switch from the vehicle. INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 1. Install the electrical connector to the stop lamp switch (1). 2. Position the stop lamp switch (1) on the pushrod (2) and install the assembly on the brake pedal pin. 3. Install the pushrod retainer (3) to the brake pedal pin (4). The retainer will snap into place. 4. Install the left sound insulator. Page 4970 If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs SIR/SRS WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS, and the wiring components, such as connectors and terminals. IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system terminals. Use either an SIR/SRS pigtail or a terminated lead from the SIR Repair Kit Tray. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves, in order to repair the SIR/SRS wiring - A special crimping tool - A heat torch - An instruction manual The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides the necessary low resistance contact integrity for these sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors SIR/SRS CONNECTOR REPAIR (PLASTIC BODY AND TERMINAL METAL PIN) The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made with a special plating. This plating provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. Use the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit for repairing SIR/SRS terminals and connectors. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the repair kit. The J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit contains: Various terminated leads for sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) terminal replacement - Various connector positive assurance (CPA) locks for SIR/SRS connectors - Base of steering column pigtail connectors part number 12085514 - Yellow vinyl electrical tape Pigtail repair packs are available for SIR/SRS connectors with eight or less terminals. Only the connector body is available for connectors with more than eight terminals. The terminated leads in the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit can be used to replace damaged terminals when replacing the connector body. SIR/SRS COMPONENT WIRE PIGTAIL REPAIR IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails. A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device, not by a connector. If a wiring pigtail is damaged, you must replace the entire component, with pigtail. The inflatable restraint steering wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component. SIR/SRS WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 1392 Open the harness by removing any tape. 2. Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. 3. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 4. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent american wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 5. Slide a section of high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing down the length of wire to be spliced. Ensure that the shrink tubing will not interfere with the splice procedure. 6. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 7. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. 8. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 9. Insert the wire into the DuraSeal splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 10. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Diagram Information and Instructions Radiator Cooling Fan Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions Electrical Symbols Page 3769 MOLEX CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. 2. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. Page 4938 4. Slide the dress cover forward and off of the connector. 5. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front and rear of the connector. Page 4371 to analyze the data during the time a vehicle condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a trigger point that you have determined. Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2 snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a first-in, first-out basis. If a third snapshot is taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost. Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types: Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice - Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200 frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not lost if the Scan Tool is powered down. The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis. The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected values by plotting 3 parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful, especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC. Testing for a Short to Voltage TESTING FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4. Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt, there is a short to voltage in the circuit. Testing for Continuity TESTING FOR CONTINUITY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6. Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit. 7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity. With a Test Lamp IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits. 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6. If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity. Testing for Electrical Intermittents TESTING FOR ELECTRICAL INTERMITTENTS Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment. - Testing for Short to Ground - Testing for Continuity - Testing for a Short to Voltage Page 4482 It is very important to use the correct test adapter when testing for proper terminal contact of fuses and relays in a bussed electrical center (BEC). Use J-35616-35 to test for proper terminal contact. Failure to use J-35616-35 can result in improper diagnosis of the BEC. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Separate the connector halves. 2. Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body. 3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J-38125 , test that the retention force is significantly different between a good terminal and a suspect terminal. Replace the female terminal in question. FLAT WIRE (DOCK AND LOCK) CONNECTORS There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock) connectors on the harness side or the component side. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Remove the component in question. 2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side of the connector as oil from your skin may be a source of contamination as well. 3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other imperfections that could cause poor terminal contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are uniform and free of damage or deformation. 4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the on the flat wire harness connector in order to test the circuit in question. CONTROL MODULE/COMPONENT VOLTAGE AND GROUNDS Poor voltage or ground connections can cause widely varying symptoms. Test all control module voltage supply circuits. Many vehicles have multiple circuits supplying voltage to a control module. Other components in the system may have separate voltage supply circuits that may also need to be tested. Inspect connections at the module/component connectors, fuses, and any intermediate connections between the voltage source and the module/component. A test lamp or a DMM may indicate that voltage is present, but neither tests the ability of the circuit to carry sufficient current. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Power Distribution Schematics. - Test all control module ground and system ground circuits. The control module may have multiple ground circuits. Other components in the system may have separate grounds that may also need to be tested. Inspect grounds for clean and tight connections at the grounding point. Inspect the connections at the component and in splice packs, where applicable. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Ground Distribution Schematics. TEMPERATURE SENSITIVITY - An intermittent condition may occur when a component/connection reaches normal operating temperature. The condition may occur only when the component/connection is cold, or only when the component/connection is hot. - Freeze Frame, Failure Records, Snapshot, or Vehicle Data Recorder data may help with this type of intermittent condition, where applicable. - If the intermittent is related to heat, review the data for a relationship with the following: High ambient temperatures - Underhood/engine generated heat - Circuit generated heat due to a poor connection, or high electrical load - Higher than normal load conditions, towing, etc. - If the intermittent is related to cold, review the data for the following: Low ambient temperatures-In extremely low temperatures, ice may form in a connection or component. Inspect for water intrusion. - The condition only occurs on a cold start. - The condition goes away when the vehicle warms up. - Information from the customer may help to determine if the trouble follows a pattern that is temperature related. - If temperature is suspected of causing an intermittent fault condition, attempt to duplicate the condition. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required. ELECTROMAGNETIC INTERFERENCE (EMI) AND ELECTRICAL NOISE Some electrical components/circuits are sensitive to electromagnetic interference (EMI) or other types of electrical noise. Inspect for the following conditions: A misrouted harness that is too close to high voltage/high current devices such as secondary ignition components, motors, generator etc-These components may induce electrical noise on a circuit that could interfere with normal circuit operation. - Electrical system interference caused by a malfunctioning relay, or a control module driven solenoid or switch-These conditions can cause a sharp electrical surge. Normally, the condition will occur when the malfunctioning component is operating. - Improper installation of non-factory or aftermarket add on accessories such as lights, 2-way radios, amplifiers, electric motors, remote starters, alarm systems, cell phones, etc-These accessories may lead to interference while in use, but do not fail when the accessories are not in use. - Test for an open diode across the A/C compressor clutch and for other open diodes. Some relays may contain a clamping diode. - The generator may be allowing AC noise into the electrical system. INCORRECT CONTROL MODULE - There are only a few situations where reprogramming a control module is appropriate: A new service control module is installed. Page 6011 6. Gently pry the plastic terminal retainer down and carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (16-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. While depressing the lock, pull the two connector halves apart. Page 6409 Page 6332 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert terminal into the appropriate terminal holder until it hits bottom and stops. The correct terminal holder is determined by the wire size. Also ensure that the terminals wings are pointing towards the former on the tool and the release locator. 5. Insert the stripped cable into the terminal. Insulation should be visible on both sides of the terminal insulation wings. 6. Compress the handles until the ratchet automatically releases. 7. Place the terminal into the appropriate cavity and assemble the connector. Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO-PACK 100W) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W connectors. These connectors are very similar but use different terminals and have some minor physical differences also. Page 2665 1 - Body Control Module 2 - Fuse Block - Rear 3 - Body Control Module Connectors C1 and C2 4 Rollover Sensor Page 8863 11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the solder equipment. 12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. 13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to cover the first piece of tape. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE SLEEVES TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit IMPORTANT: Use only dura seal splice sleeves. Other splice sleeves may not protect the splice from moisture or provide a good electrical connection. Use duraseal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. Use duraseal splice sleeves where there is special requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire using duraseal splice sleeves. Page 275 Driver Door Module (DDM) C5 (Outside Rearview Mirror Switch) (DS3/DL2) Page 1695 Utility/Van Zoning UTILITY/VAN ZONING Page 2182 Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Connector Views Engine Controls Connector End Views Mass Air Flow (MAF)/Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor Engine - Revised Connecting Rod Bolt Torque Connecting Rod: Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Revised Connecting Rod Bolt Torque Bulletin No.: 07-06-01-002 Date: March 05, 2007 INFORMATION Subject: Information on Revised Connecting Rod Bolt Torque for Small Block GEN III and GEN IV Vortec(TM) V8 Engines Models A new connecting rod bolt torque specification was introduced to the GEN III and GEN IV Vortec(TM) small block V8 engines. The connecting rod bolts should continue to be tightened using two passes. The second pass value has been increased from 75 degrees to 85 degrees. Install the connecting rod bolts and tighten. Refer to Piston, Connecting Rod, and Bearing Installation in SI. Tighten Tighten the connecting rod bolts a first pass to 20 N.m (15 lb ft). Tighten the connecting rod bolts a final pass to 85 degrees using the J 45059 Angle Meter. Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 04-06-04-054B Date: November 18, 2010 Subject: Info - Non-GM Parts and Accessories (Aftermarket) Models: 2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years and update to the new U.S. Fixed Operation Manager (FOM) and Canada Warranty Manager (WM) names. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 04-06-04-054A (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). The recent rise and expansion of companies selling non-GM parts and accessories has made it necessary to issue this reminder to dealers regarding GM's policy on the use and installation of these aftermarket components. When a dealer is performing a repair under the New Vehicle Limited Warranty, they are required to use only genuine GM or GM-approved parts and accessories. This applies to all warranty repairs, special policy repairs or any repairs paid for by GM. Parts and accessories advertised as being "the same" as parts manufactured by GM, but not sold through GM, do not qualify for use in warranty repairs, special policy repairs or any repairs paid for by GM. During a warranty repair, if a GM original equipment part is not available through GM Customer Care and Aftersales (GM CC&A;), ACDelco(R) distributors, other GM dealers or approved sources, the dealer is to obtain comparable, non-GM parts and clearly indicate, in detail, on the repair order the circumstances surrounding why non-GM parts were used. The dealer must give customers written notice, prior to the sale or service, that such parts or accessories are not marketed or warranted by General Motors. It should also be noted that dealers modifying new vehicles and installing equipment, parts and accessories obtained from sources not authorized by GM are responsible for complying with the National Traffic and Motor Vehicle Safety Act. Certain non-approved parts or assemblies, installed by the dealer or its agent not authorized by GM, may result in a change to the vehicle's design characteristics and may affect the vehicle's ability to conform to federal law. Dealers must fully understand that non-GM approved parts may not have been validated, tested or certified for use. This puts the dealer at risk for potential liability in the event of a part or vehicle failure. If a GM part failure occurs as the result of the installation or use of a non-GM approved part, the warranty will not be honored. A good example of non-authorized modification of vehicles is the result of an ever increasing supply of aftermarket devices available to the customer, which claim to increase the horsepower and torque of the Duramax(TM) Diesel Engines. These include the addition of, but are not limited to one or more of the following modifications: - Propane injection - Nitrous oxide injection - Additional modules (black boxes) that connect to the vehicle wiring systems - Revised engine calibrations downloaded for the engine control module - Calibration modules which connect to the vehicle diagnostic connector - Modification to the engine turbocharger waste gate Although the installation of these devices, or modification of vehicle components, can increase engine horsepower and torque, they may also negatively affect the engine emissions, reliability and/or durability. In addition, other powertrain components, such as transmissions, universal joints, drive shafts, and front/rear axle components, can be stressed beyond design safety limits by the installation of these devices. General Motors does not support or endorse the use of devices or modifications that, when installed, increase the engine horsepower and torque. It is because of these unknown stresses, and the potential to alter reliability, durability and emissions performance, that GM has adopted a policy that prevents any UNAUTHORIZED dealer warranty claim submissions to any remaining warranty coverage, to the powertrain and driveline components whenever the presence of a non-GM (aftermarket) calibration is confirmed - even if the non-GM control module calibration is subsequently removed. Refer to the latest version of Bulletin 09-06-04-026 (V8 Gas Engines) or 06-06-01-007 (Duramax(TM) Diesel Engines) for more information on dealer requirements for calibration verification. These same policies apply as they relate to the use of non-GM accessories. Damage or failure from the use or installation of a non-GM accessory will not be covered under warranty. Failure resulting from the alteration or modification of the vehicle, including the cutting, welding or disconnecting of the vehicle's original equipment parts and components will void the warranty. Additionally, dealers will NOT be reimbursed or compensated by GM in the event of any legal inquiry at either the local, state or federal level that Page 2015 View of typical connector. View of connector in released position. 1. Locate the assist lever at the back of the connector. Move the assist lever to the rear position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the dress cover. Page 5600 breakers are used. CIRCUIT BREAKER This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high current is removed. POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) CIRCUIT BREAKER This type greatly increases its resistance when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker will re-close within a second or 2. Circuit Protection - Fuses CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSES The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and examine the element in the fuse for an open (2). If not broken (1), also check for continuity using a DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one of equal current rating. Circuit Protection - Fusible Links CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSIBLE LINKS Page 6717 7. The illustration above identifies the entry canal where the terminal release tool will be inserted, and the terminal cavity. - Terminal (1) - Entry Canal (2) 8. Insert the J-38125-553 (15315247) tool into the entry canal and pry up on the terminal retainer. The terminal retainer is a small plastic piece on the top of the terminal. The terminal retainer must be held up while the terminal is pulled out of the connector. Page 7955 15. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground wire terminal. 16. Install the electrical ground wire terminal to the rivet stud. 17. Select a M6 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 18. Install the M6 conductive nut to the rivet stud and: Tighten Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb in). 19. Verify proper system operation. M6 Weld Nut Caution Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground repair. 1. If the M6 weld nut at the electrical ground location is damaged or stripped, a M7 conductive self-threading bolt may be used to secure the ground wire terminal. 2. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the surface surrounding the weld nut and allow to dry. 3. Remove any loose metal particles from the damaged or stripped weld nut with a stiff brush. 4. Select a M7 conductive self-threading bolt. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin 5. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M7 conductive self-threading bolt. Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase. 6. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground wire terminal. 7. Install the electrical ground wire terminal to the M7 conductive self-threading bolt. 8. Install the M7 conductive self-threading bolt and: Tighten Tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb in). 9. Verify proper system operation. M6 Weld Nut Alternative Repair Caution Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground repair. 1. If the electrical ground location is accessible from both sides of the panel, a M6 conductive bolt and a M6 conductive nut may be used to secure the electrical ground wire terminal. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 2. Select a location adjacent the damaged M6 weld nut having 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance behind the panel surface and 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance surrounding the new electrical ground site. 3. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the surface surrounding the ground location and allow to dry. Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled. 4. Drill a 8.5 mm (0.33 in) diameter hole through the panel. 5. Remove paint and primer from the area surrounding the 8.5 mm (0.33 in) hole until bare metal is visible. 6. Select a M6 conductive bolt. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 7. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M6 conductive bolt. Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase. 8. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground wire terminal. 9. Install the electrical ground wire terminal and the M6 conductive bolt to the ground location. 10. Select a M6 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 11. Install the M6 conductive nut to the bolt and: Page 9026 11. Insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) into the 2 triangular cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 12. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE 1. Prior to installation the terminal must be aligned so the (1) coding lugs align with the (2) coding grooves on the connector. 2. Once the terminal is aligned, slide the terminal into the cavity until the retainer has engaged in the cavity of the connector. 3. Slide the TPA in the connector body and seat it using a small flat bladed tool. The TPA is seated when it is flush with the contact housing. 4. Secure the wires to the connector body using a tie wrap and replace the dress cover and grommet. Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) BOSCH CONNECTORS (2.8 JPT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Pull out the slider on the connector position assurance (CPA) until it is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 665 Disclaimer Page 8649 Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Displays and Gages Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Entertainment/Communication Schematic Icons Page 2364 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the rear TPA from the connector. 7. IMPORTANT: The front TPA cannot be removed from the connector. Only move it to the release point. Use a small flat-blade tool to move the front TPA to the release position. 8. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 9. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Molex Connectors Page 478 View of connector in released position. 4. Disconnect the connector from the component. 5. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Release the rear lower half of the wiredress cover. Page 4247 Important: ^ Do not reuse the crankshaft oil seal or front cover gasket. ^ Do not apply any type of sealant to the front cover gasket, unless specified. ^ The special tool in this procedure is used to properly center the front crankshaft front oil seal. - All gasket surfaces should be free of oil or other foreign material during assembly. The crankshaft front oil seal MUST be centered in relation to the crankshaft. - An improperly aligned front cover may cause premature front oil seal wear and/or engine oil leaks. Apply a 5 mm (0.2 in) bead of sealant 20 mm (0.8 in) long to the junction of the oil pan and the engine block. Refer to Sealers, Adhesives, and Lubricants for the correct part number. 1. Install the front cover gasket and cover. 2. Install the front cover bolts until snug. Do not over tighten. 3. Install the oil pan-to-front cover bolts until snug. Do not over tighten. 4. Install J 41476 to the front cover. 5. Align the tapered legs of J 41476 with the machined alignment surfaces on the front cover. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 6. Install the crankshaft balancer bolt until snug. Do NOT over tighten. 1. Tighten the oil pan to front cover bolts to 25 N.m (18 lb ft). 2. Tighten the engine front cover bolts to 25 N.m (18 lb ft). 7. Remove J 41476. Page 4529 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. 4. Remove the dress cover by using a flat bladed tool to release the dress cover locking tabs and lift up on the dress cover. 5. Cut the tie wrap that holds the wires to the connector body. Page 7732 For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 5877 If a wire is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm, etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except coaxial. - Do not use the DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent American wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 8900 Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested: - Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. - Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a component or to other harnesses. - If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A TEST LAMP TOOLS REQUIRED J 35616-200 Test Light - Probe Kit NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminate even though voltage is present. The J 35616-200 is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair of leads. To properly operate this tool use the following procedures. When testing for voltage: 1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested. When testing for ground: 1. Attach one lead to battery positive voltage. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where ground should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is ground at the point being tested. Using Connector Test Adapters USING CONNECTOR TEST ADAPTERS NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Using Fused Jumper Wires USING FUSED JUMPER WIRES TOOLS REQUIRED J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged. The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested. AFL/ECP Connectors AFL/EPC CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 6692 7. Apply pressure and gently rock the cover until one locking leg is unseated. 8. Continue to apply pressure and rock the cover until the second locking leg is unseated. Repeat procedure for the other side of the dress cover and remove the cover. 9. Use J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) to gently lift the terminal retaining tab while gently pulling the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 10. If the terminal is severely bent or damaged, it may be possible on some connectors to push the wire out of the front of the connector instead of Page 8047 7. Pressing the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool in the release cavity of the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and crimper in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (DOOR MODULE) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Side view of connector. View of top of connector. 1. Locate the assist lever and lock on the top of the connector. Page 8010 - Most Molex connectors will have the Molex logo on the dresscover of the connector. In some cases the connectors may have MX followed by another letter. The third letter indicates where the connector was made. A connector with MXD is a Molex connector made in Detroit. Sumitomo has a unique symbol on their connector and possibly a part number. The symbol is similar to that of a diamond lying on its side, similar to that shown. The logo could appear anywhere but the most common place is at the wire side of the housing. Tyco/AMP has many different and unique connector designs. Some may or may not have identifiable marks on them. Page 5875 breakers are used. CIRCUIT BREAKER This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high current is removed. POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) CIRCUIT BREAKER This type greatly increases its resistance when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker will re-close within a second or 2. Circuit Protection - Fuses CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSES The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and examine the element in the fuse for an open (2). If not broken (1), also check for continuity using a DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one of equal current rating. Circuit Protection - Fusible Links CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSIBLE LINKS Page 6033 Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Bank 2 Sensor 1 Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Bank 2 Sensor 2 Page 59 For vehicles repaired under warranty use, the table. Disclaimer Page 936 Caution When performing service on or near the SIR components or the SIR wiring, the SIR system must be disabled. Failure to observe the correct procedure could cause deployment of the SIR components. Serious injury can occur. Failure to observe the correct procedure could also result in unnecessary SIR system repairs. 1. Perform the Diagnostic System Check-Vehicle. 2. Identify the DTC that is set AND review the DTC Descriptor in the corresponding diagnostic procedure. Refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List-Vehicle in SI. 3. Using the information from the DTC Descriptor, determine the location of the affected electrical connector. Refer to SIR Identification Views and the Master Electrical Component List in SI. 4. Turn OFF the ignition and disable the supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system. Refer to SIR Disabling and Enabling in SI. 5. BEFORE removing, INSPECT the CPA retainer at the electrical connector. Note The connector and connector position assurance (CPA) may seat independent of each other. Both the connector and CPA should seat with an audible and/or tactile click. The CPA isolates the shorting-bars within the connector allowing the deployment circuit to operate properly. ‹› If the CPA retainer is loose, damaged, or will not seat in the connector, replace it with a new one. Reinstall the CPA correctly by first pushing the connector body in completely, and then pushing the CPA retainer in completely. ‹› If the CPA retainer is not loose or damaged and is properly seated, proceed to Step 6. 6. Remove the CPA retainer and disconnect the electrical connector. Inspect the terminals for the following conditions: - Corrosion - Contamination - Terminal tension - Damage Important The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made with a special plating. This plating provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. Use the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit for repairing SIR/SRS terminals and connectors. DO NOT substitute any other terminals for those in the repair kit. ‹› If the terminals are damaged, corrosion is observed, or have poor tension, repair or replace as necessary. Apply dielectric grease, GM P/N 12345579 (in Canada, use P/N 10953481) on the connector pins and terminals when reassembling. Refer to SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs in SI. Note The connector and connector position assurance (CPA) may seat independent of each other. Both the connector and CPA should seat with an audible and/or tactile click. The CPA isolates the shorting-bars within the connector allowing the deployment circuit to operate properly. 7. Connect the electrical connector, and install the CPA retainer. 8. Enable the supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system. Refer to SIR Disabling and Enabling in SI. 9. Clear the DTC with a scan tool. 10. Verify that the DTC does not reset by performing the Diagnostic Repair Verification in SI. ‹› If any DTC resets, then refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle in SI. Parts Information Note If the CPA retainer P/N 54590003 (Orange CPA) cannot be located in the J-38125 SIR/SRS terminal repair kit, contact Kent Moore Tools and order P/N 54590003-PKG to obtain a package of 5. Service and Repair Cabin Air Filter: Service and Repair This vehicle is not equipped with a factory installed passenger compartment air filter. Page 3584 Important Other forms of slow air leaks are possible. If the body of the tire, valve stem and wheel flange show no signs of air seepage, refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 05-03-10-003D for additional information on possible wheel porosity issues. 3. Bead seat corrosion is identified by what appears like blistering of the wheel finish, causing a rough or uneven surface that is difficult for the tire to maintain a proper seal on. Below is a close-up photo of bead seat corrosion on an aluminum wheel that was sufficient to cause slow air loss. Close-Up of Bead Seat Corrosion 4. If corrosion is found on the wheel bead seat, measure the affected area as shown below. - For vehicles with 32,186 km (20,000 mi) or less, the total allowable combined linear area of repairable corrosion is 100 mm (4 in) or less. If the total area(s) of corrosion exceed these dimensions, the wheel should be replaced. - For vehicles that have exceeded 32,186 km (20,000 mi), the total allowable combined linear area of repairable corrosion is 200 mm (8 in) or less. If the total area(s) of corrosion exceed these dimensions, the wheel should be replaced. 5. In order to correct the wheel leak, use a clean-up (fine cut) sanding disc or biscuit to remove the corrosion and any flaking paint. You should remove the corrosion back far enough until you reach material that is stable and firmly bonded to the wheel. Try to taper the edge of any flaking paint as best you can in order to avoid sharp edges that may increase the chance of a leak reoccurring. The photo below shows an acceptable repaired surface. Notice Corrosion that extends up the lip of the wheel, where after the clean-up process it would be visible with the tire mounted, is only acceptable on the inboard flange. The inboard flange is not visible with the wheel assembly in the mounted position. If any loose coatings or corrosion extend to the visible surfaces on the FACE of the wheel, that wheel must be replaced. Important Remove ONLY the material required to eliminate the corrosion from the bead seating surface. DO NOT remove excessive amounts of material. ALWAYS keep the sealing surface as smooth and level as possible. Page 1576 View of connector in released position. 4. Disconnect the connector from the component. 5. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Release the rear lower half of the wiredress cover. Page 9042 pulling it through. This will prevent damage to the internal seals of the connector. Once the terminal is pushed out of the connector, cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible and pull the wire through the connector. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE The Micro-Pack 100W connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool was developed to crimp Micro-Pack 100W terminals. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 2. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert the terminal into the crimp tool until the core wings are flush with the anvil on the crimp tool. Be sure that the wings are pointed toward the crimp tool former and release the spring locator. The locator will hold the terminal in place. Inspect the alignment of the terminal wings with the crimp tool former. If the terminal wings are wider than the crimp tool former, remove the terminal and bend the terminal wings in slightly. 5. Place stripped wire into terminal. 6. Crimp the new terminal to the wire. If a jam occurs, press the emergency release to open applicator. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire perform the following procedure in order to replace Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair Wiring Harness: All Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 10-08-45-001B Date: October 25, 2010 Subject: Information for Electrical Ground Repair - Use New Replacement Fasteners with Conductive Finish Models: 2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2011 model year and update the Warranty Information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 10-08-45-001A (Section 08 - Body and Accessories). Electrical Ground Repair Overview Proper electrical system function relies on secure, stable and corrosion-free electrical ground connections. Loose, stripped, or corroded connections increase the possibility of improper system function and loss of module communication. These conditions may also lead to unnecessary repairs and component replacement. In general, electrical ground connections are accomplished using one, or a combination of the following attachment methods: - Welded M6 stud and nut - Welded M6 nut and bolt - Welded M8 nut and bolt Determine which attachment method is used and perform the appropriate or alternative repair as described in this bulletin. M6 Weld Stud Replacement Caution Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground repair. 1. Select a location adjacent the damaged or missing M6 ground stud having 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance behind the panel surface and 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance surrounding the M6 conductive rivet stud flange. 2. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the repair site and allow to dry. Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled. 3. Drill a 10 mm (0.40 in) diameter hole through the panel. 4. Remove paint and primer from the area surrounding the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole until bare metal is visible. Page 5325 TERMINAL REMOVAL Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors. 1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA) device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1). 3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 4. Gently pull the cable and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector. 5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal, refer to Terminal Repair. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3. Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector. REINSTALLING TERMINAL 1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly, refer to Wiring Repairs. 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3. Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) DELPHI CONNECTORS (WEATHER PACK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 8503 Page 3208 1. Place the ignition in the OFF position. 2. Install the fuse(s) supplying power to the SDM. 3. Turn the ignition switch to the ON position. The AIR BAG indicator will flash then turn OFF. 4. Perform the Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle if the AIR BAG warning indicator does not operate as described. Refer to Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle. See: Testing and Inspection/Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview/Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle Disabling Procedure - Negative Battery Cable 1. Turn the steering wheel so that the vehicles wheels are pointing straight ahead. 2. Place the ignition in the OFF position. 3. Disconnect the negative battery cable from the battery. 4. Wait 1 minute before working on system. Enabling Procedure - Negative Battery Cable 1. Place the ignition in the OFF position. 2. Connect the negative battery cable to the battery. 3. Turn the ignition switch to the ON position. The AIR BAG indicator will flash then turn OFF. 4. Perform the Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle if the AIR BAG warning indicator does not operate as described. Refer to Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle. See: Testing and Inspection/Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview/Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle Page 7285 8. Take a CLEAR digital picture of the Tech 2(R) Vehicle Information screen showing the engine Calibration IDs and Verification Numbers as shown above. Retain the printout information and the Tech 2(R) screen photograph with the repair order. 9. E-mail a copy of the picture to [email protected]. In the subject line of the e-mail include the phrase "V8 Cal" as well as the complete VIN and Dealer BAC. In the body of the e-mail, include the VIN, mileage, R.O. number and BAC. Include a brief description of the customer concern and cause of the concern. Note The dealer will receive an e-mail reply after the calibrations have been validated. The e-mail reply will advise the dealer if the calibrations are OEM. 10. Allow two hours for the PQC to verify the calibrations and set up the case details. ‹› If the PQC determines that the calibrations ARE aftermarket calibrations, DO NOT contact GM Technical Assistance to discuss warranty concerns on the aftermarket calibrations. ALL questions and concerns about warranty should be directed to the dealers Fixed Operations Manager (FOM), (Warranty Manager (WM) in Canada). 11. You may call the PQC two hours after submitting the e-mail for authorization to replace the assembly. This will provide them time to receive, review and set up a case on the request. Please be prepared to provide all the usual documentation that is normally required when requesting an assembly authorization from the PQC. Tech 2(R) Displaying All Zeroes for the Verification Numbers on the Calibration ID and Verification Number Screen If the Tech 2(R) that you are using displays all zeroes for the Verification Numbers as shown, then perform the following steps: 1. Update the Tech 2(R) with the latest software from TIS2WEB. 2. Turn OFF the ignition for 90 seconds. 3. Connect the Tech 2(R) to the vehicle. 4. Turn ON the ignition, and build the vehicle. Observe the Tech 2(R) Calibration ID and Verification Number screen for proper operation. ‹› If the Tech 2(R) screen still does not display properly, then turn OFF the ignition for 90 seconds again. Turn ON the ignition and observe the same screen for proper operation. Retrieving Calibrations From a Global A Vehicle This information applies to the 2010 Camaro and is typical of the procedure that will be used on Global A vehicles. 1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Connect the MDI to the Data Link Connector (DLC) of the vehicle. Note Use the USB port to make the following MDI connection: Page 7362 7. Apply pressure and gently rock the cover until one locking leg is unseated. 8. Continue to apply pressure and rock the cover until the second locking leg is unseated. Repeat procedure for the other side of the dress cover and remove the cover. 9. Use J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) to gently lift the terminal retaining tab while gently pulling the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 10. If the terminal is severely bent or damaged, it may be possible on some connectors to push the wire out of the front of the connector instead of Page 8594 If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs SIR/SRS WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS, and the wiring components, such as connectors and terminals. IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system terminals. Use either an SIR/SRS pigtail or a terminated lead from the SIR Repair Kit Tray. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves, in order to repair the SIR/SRS wiring - A special crimping tool - A heat torch - An instruction manual The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides the necessary low resistance contact integrity for these sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors SIR/SRS CONNECTOR REPAIR (PLASTIC BODY AND TERMINAL METAL PIN) The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made with a special plating. This plating provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. Use the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit for repairing SIR/SRS terminals and connectors. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the repair kit. The J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit contains: Various terminated leads for sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) terminal replacement - Various connector positive assurance (CPA) locks for SIR/SRS connectors - Base of steering column pigtail connectors part number 12085514 - Yellow vinyl electrical tape Pigtail repair packs are available for SIR/SRS connectors with eight or less terminals. Only the connector body is available for connectors with more than eight terminals. The terminated leads in the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit can be used to replace damaged terminals when replacing the connector body. SIR/SRS COMPONENT WIRE PIGTAIL REPAIR IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails. A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device, not by a connector. If a wiring pigtail is damaged, you must replace the entire component, with pigtail. The inflatable restraint steering wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component. SIR/SRS WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 7323 All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system. Page 6693 pulling it through. This will prevent damage to the internal seals of the connector. Once the terminal is pushed out of the connector, cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible and pull the wire through the connector. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE The Micro-Pack 100W connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool was developed to crimp Micro-Pack 100W terminals. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 2. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert the terminal into the crimp tool until the core wings are flush with the anvil on the crimp tool. Be sure that the wings are pointed toward the crimp tool former and release the spring locator. The locator will hold the terminal in place. Inspect the alignment of the terminal wings with the crimp tool former. If the terminal wings are wider than the crimp tool former, remove the terminal and bend the terminal wings in slightly. 5. Place stripped wire into terminal. 6. Crimp the new terminal to the wire. If a jam occurs, press the emergency release to open applicator. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire perform the following procedure in order to replace Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. Page 7243 Diagram Information and Instructions Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay: Diagram Information and Instructions Electrical Symbols Page 5214 7. Pressing the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool in the release cavity of the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and crimper in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (DOOR MODULE) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Side view of connector. View of top of connector. 1. Locate the assist lever and lock on the top of the connector. Radiator Replacement Radiator: Service and Repair Radiator Replacement Radiator Replacement (LH6, LS2) Tools Required ^ J 41240 Fan Clutch Remover and Installer ^ J 38185 Hose Clamp Pliers Removal Procedure 1. Drain the coolant from the radiator. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System (LL8) Draining and Filling Cooling System (LH6, LS2). 2. Remove the lower radiator support shield, if equipped. Refer to Radiator Support Shield Replacement. 3. Remove the transmission cooler lines from the radiator. Refer to Transmission Fluid Cooler Hose/Pipe Quick-Connect Fitting Replacement for the 4L60-E/4L65-E transmission. 4. Reposition the outlet radiator hose clamp using J 38185. 5. Remove the outlet radiator hose (1) from the radiator. 6. Lower the vehicle. 7. Reposition the inlet radiator hose clamp using J 38185. 8. Remove the inlet radiator hose from the radiator. 9. Remove the cooling fan and shroud. Refer to Cooling Fan and Shroud Replacement. 10. Remove the air inlet grille. Refer to Air Inlet Grille Panel Replacement (Envoy, TrailBlazer) Air Inlet Grille Panel Replacement (Rainier). Page 7280 Note All pictures must be sent as a.jpg file. 27. E-mail a copy of the screenshot to [email protected]. In the subject line of the e-mail include the phrase "V8 Cal" as well as the complete VIN and Dealer BAC. In the body of the e-mail, include the VIN, mileage, R.O. number and BAC. Include a brief description of the customer concern and cause of the concern. Note The dealer will receive an e-mail reply after the calibrations have been validated. The e-mail reply will advise the dealer if the calibrations are OEM. 28. Allow two hours for the PQC to verify the calibrations and set up the case details. ‹› If the PQC determines that the calibrations ARE aftermarket calibrations, DO NOT contact GM Technical Assistance to discuss warranty concerns on the aftermarket calibrations. ALL questions and concerns about warranty should be directed to the dealers Fixed Operations Manager (FOM), (Warranty Manager (WM) in Canada). 29. You may call the PQC two hours after submitting the e-mail for authorization to replace the assembly. This will provide them time to receive, review and set up a case on the request. Please be prepared to provide all the usual documentation that is normally required when requesting an assembly authorization from the PQC. Warranty Information - The Dealership Service Management must be involved in any situation that would justify the use of labor operation Z1111. - Notify the Fixed Operations Manager (FOM) (Warranty Manager (WM) in Canada) of the situation. - All claims will have to be routed to the FOM (WM in Canada) for approval. - Please refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 09-00-89-016, Labor Operation Z1111 - Suspected Tampering or Vehicle Modifications for important information. For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Service Precautions Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Service Precautions Handling Idle Air Control Valve Notice Notice: If the IAC valve has been in service: DO NOT push or pull on the IAC valve pintle. The force required to move the pintle may damage the threads on the worm drive. Also, DO NOT soak the IAC valve in any liquid cleaner or solvent, as damage may result. Diagram Information and Instructions Valve Deactivation Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions Electrical Symbols Page 5977 The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors. 1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position. 4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool J 38125-10A (GM P/N 12014012-1) into the front (mating end) of the connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal through the back of the connector (2). IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector. 6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. 7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily. 10. Perform system check. Delphi Connectors (12 Way) DELPHI CONNECTORS (12-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. Exhaust System - Catalytic Converter Precautions Catalytic Converter: Technical Service Bulletins Exhaust System - Catalytic Converter Precautions Bulletin No.: 06-06-01-010A Date: February 04, 2008 INFORMATION Subject: Information on Close-Coupled Converter and Engine Breakdown or Non-Function Due to Severe Overheat or Lack of Oil Causing Piston(s) Connecting Rod(s) Crankshaft Cylinder(s) and/or Head(s) Camshaft(s) Intake and/or Exhaust Valve(s) Main and/or Rod Bearing(s) Damage Models: 2004-2008 GM Passenger Cars and Trucks with Close-Coupled Catalytic Converters Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 06-06-01-010 (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). Certain 2004-2008 General Motors products may be equipped with a new style of catalytic converter technically known as the close-coupled catalytic converter providing quick catalyst warm-up resulting in lower tail pipe emissions earlier in the vehicle operating cycle. If an engine breakdown or non-function were to occur (such as broken intake/exhaust valve or piston) debris may be deposited in the converter through engine exhaust ports. If the engine is non-functioning due to a severe overheat event damage to the ceramic "brick" internal to the catalytic converter may occur. This may result in ceramic debris being drawn into the engine through the cylinder head exhaust ports. If a replacement engine is installed in either of these instances the replacement engine may fail due to the debris being introduced into the combustion chambers when started. When replacing an engine for a breakdown or non-function an inspection of the catalytic converters and ALL transferred components (such as exhaust/ intake manifolds) should be performed. Any debris found should be removed. In cases of engine failure due to severe overheat dealers should also inspect each catalytic converter for signs of melting or cracking of the ceramic "brick". If damage is observed the converter should be replaced. Disclaimer Page 853 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Ensure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the Terminal Removal Procedure. Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PULL TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL If the terminal is visibly damaged or is suspected of having a faulty connection, the terminal should be replaced. Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors: 1. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) device and/or the secondary lock. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component or separate the connectors for in-line connectors. 3. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device. 4. Insert the proper pick or removal tool into the front of the connector body. 5. IMPORTANT: On connectors with more than one terminal the service loop may not be large enough to remove the terminal and crimp on a new one. If the terminal wire does not have a large enough service loop for removal, cut the wire 5 cm (2 in) behind the connector before removal. Grasp the wire at the back of the connector body and gently push the terminal out the front of the connector body. TERMINAL REPAIR 1. If the wire needed to be cut in order to remove the terminal, gently push a small length of the same size wire through the back of the connector cavity until there is enough wire exposed in order to crimp on a new terminal. If the wire was not cut, cut the existing wire as close to the old terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Crimp a new terminal to the wire. 4. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. TERMINAL INSTALLATION 1. Align the terminal and pull the wire from the back of the connector in order to seat the terminal. 2. If necessary, cut the new wire to proper length and splice with existing circuit. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. 3. If the connector is outside of the passenger compartment, apply dielectric grease to the connector. 4. Install the TPA, CPA, and/or the secondary locks. Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) DELPHI CONNECTORS (PUSH TO SEAT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 8216 Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Connector Views Engine Controls Connector End Views Mass Air Flow (MAF)/Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor Page 2508 If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs SIR/SRS WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS, and the wiring components, such as connectors and terminals. IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system terminals. Use either an SIR/SRS pigtail or a terminated lead from the SIR Repair Kit Tray. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves, in order to repair the SIR/SRS wiring - A special crimping tool - A heat torch - An instruction manual The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides the necessary low resistance contact integrity for these sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors SIR/SRS CONNECTOR REPAIR (PLASTIC BODY AND TERMINAL METAL PIN) The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made with a special plating. This plating provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. Use the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit for repairing SIR/SRS terminals and connectors. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the repair kit. The J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit contains: Various terminated leads for sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) terminal replacement - Various connector positive assurance (CPA) locks for SIR/SRS connectors - Base of steering column pigtail connectors part number 12085514 - Yellow vinyl electrical tape Pigtail repair packs are available for SIR/SRS connectors with eight or less terminals. Only the connector body is available for connectors with more than eight terminals. The terminated leads in the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit can be used to replace damaged terminals when replacing the connector body. SIR/SRS COMPONENT WIRE PIGTAIL REPAIR IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails. A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device, not by a connector. If a wiring pigtail is damaged, you must replace the entire component, with pigtail. The inflatable restraint steering wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component. SIR/SRS WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Locations Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay: Locations Fuse Block - Underhood (5.3L/6.0L), Label Page 8614 Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Diagrams Engine Controls Connector End Views Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor Page 6976 1. Locate the air flow direction arrow (2) on the MAF/IAT sensor. 2. Install the MAF/IAT sensor on to the air cleaner housing. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 3. Tighten the clamp securing the MAF/IAT sensor to the air cleaner housing. Tighten the clamp to 7 N.m (62 lb in). 4. Install the air cleaner outlet duct. 5. Install the air cleaner outlet duct bolt. Tighten the bolt to 10 N.m (89 lb in). 6. Tighten the clamps at the MAF/IAT sensor and the throttle body. Tighten the clamps to 7 N.m (62 lb in). Page 1689 Page 7857 1. If reinstalling the old sensor, coat the threads with anti-seize compound GM P/N 12377953, or equivalent. Notice: Refer to Component Fastener Tightening Notice. 2. Install the HO2S (2). Tighten the sensor to 42 N.m (31 lb ft). 3. Connect the HO2S electrical connector. 4. Install the CPA retainer. 5. Lower the vehicle. Page 9082 breakers are used. CIRCUIT BREAKER This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high current is removed. POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) CIRCUIT BREAKER This type greatly increases its resistance when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker will re-close within a second or 2. Circuit Protection - Fuses CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSES The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and examine the element in the fuse for an open (2). If not broken (1), also check for continuity using a DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one of equal current rating. Circuit Protection - Fusible Links CIRCUIT PROTECTION - FUSIBLE LINKS Page 1871 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert terminal into the appropriate terminal holder until it hits bottom and stops. The correct terminal holder is determined by the wire size. Also ensure that the terminals wings are pointing towards the former on the tool and the release locator. 5. Insert the stripped cable into the terminal. Insulation should be visible on both sides of the terminal insulation wings. 6. Compress the handles until the ratchet automatically releases. 7. Place the terminal into the appropriate cavity and assemble the connector. Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO-PACK 100W) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W connectors. These connectors are very similar but use different terminals and have some minor physical differences also. Page 6284 7. Connect the MAF/IAT electrical connector. Page 5442 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert terminal into the appropriate terminal holder until it hits bottom and stops. The correct terminal holder is determined by the wire size. Also ensure that the terminals wings are pointing towards the former on the tool and the release locator. 5. Insert the stripped cable into the terminal. Insulation should be visible on both sides of the terminal insulation wings. 6. Compress the handles until the ratchet automatically releases. 7. Place the terminal into the appropriate cavity and assemble the connector. Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO-PACK 100W) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W connectors. These connectors are very similar but use different terminals and have some minor physical differences also. Page 8420 4. Use a small flat-blade tool to slide the terminal position assurance (TPA) up one notch on both ends of the connector. The TPA is located underneath the wire dress cover. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 1722 Connector Anatomy Connector Repairs contains a list of all connector repairs. The connector repairs are listed by the connector manufacturer and then by connector type. If the technician cannot identify the manufacturer of the connector, refer to Identifying Connectors below. Knowing the connector manufacturer will assist in finding the correct connector repair from the following list: - Connector Position Assurance Locks - Terminal Position Assurance Locks - Bosch Connectors (0.64) Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) Bosch Connectors (BSK) Bosch Connectors (ECM) - Delphi Connectors (Micro.64) Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) Delphi Connectors (Pull To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Push To Seat) Delphi Connectors (Weather Pack) Delphi Connectors (12-Way) - Tyco/AMP Connectors (CM 42-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) Tyco/AMP Connectors (025 Cap) Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) - Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) Yazaki Connectors (16-Way) - Repairing Connector Terminals IDENTIFYING CONNECTORS Knowing the connector manufacturer is helpful when trying to locating the correct connector repair procedure. There are many different connector designs used on GM vehicles and it is sometimes difficult to identify the connector manufacturer. The information in this document should help with the identification of connector manufactures. The following connector manufacturers make most of the connectors found in GM vehicles: AFL/EPC (Alcoa Fujikura Ltd./Engineered Plastics Components) - Bosch - Delphi - FCI (Framatome Connectors International) - JAE (Japan Aviation Electronics) - JST (Japan Solderless Terminals) Page 6490 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Start in the middle and gradually move the heat barrel to the open ends of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Heated Oxygen Sensor Wiring Repairs HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being obstructed. If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. - Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks, etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire. - Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance. - To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector. Page 2226 - JST connectors have JST in small letters on their connectors, similar to that above. The location of the logo will vary with the connector size and style. - Kostel has an "LK" with a circle around it. These connector are usually used as a transmissions connection and are currently use on some Cadillac vehicles. Page 1546 Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Service and Repair Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure Notice: Use care when handling the coolant sensor. Damage to the coolant sensor will affect the operation of the fuel control system. 1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Raise and suitably support the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 3. Drain the cooling system below the level of the ECT sensor. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System (LL8) Draining and Filling Cooling System (LH6, LS2). 4. Lower the vehicle. 5. Disconnect the engine coolant temperature (ECT) sensor electrical connector (1). 6. Remove the ECT sensor. Installation Procedure Notice: Replacement components must be the correct part number for the application. Components requiring the use of the thread locking compound, lubricants, corrosion inhibitors, or sealants are identified in the service procedure. Some replacement components may come with these coatings already applied. Do not use these coatings on components unless specified. These coatings can affect the final torque, which may affect the operation of the component. Use the correct torque specification when installing components in order to avoid damage. Notice: Use care when handling the coolant sensor. Damage to the coolant sensor will affect the operation of the fuel control system. 1. Coat the ECT sensor threads with sealer GM P/N 12346004 (Canadian P/N 10953480), or equivalent. Page 3332 Fuse: Application and ID Rear Fuse Block Fuse Block - Rear, Label Page 6857 Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 2. Install the 3 APP sensor bolts (1). Tighten the bolts to 20 N.m (15 lb ft). 3. Connect the APP sensor electrical connector. 4. Verify that the vehicle meets the following conditions: * The vehicle is not in a reduced engine power mode. * The ignition is ON. * The engine is OFF. 5. Connect a scan tool in order to test for a proper throttle-opening and throttle-closing range. 6. Operate the accelerator pedal and monitor the throttle angles. The accelerator pedal should operate freely, without binding, between a closed throttle, and a wide open throttle. Page 2829 Wiper Switch: Service and Repair REAR WINDOW WIPER AND WASHER SWITCH REPLACEMENT REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Remove the instrument panel (I/P) accessory trim plate. 2. Disconnect the electrical connector from the wiper washer switch. 3. Release the wiper washer switch locking tabs. 4. Remove the switch from the trim plate. INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 1. Position the switch to the trim plate. 2. Connect the electrical connector to the wiper washer switch. 3. Install the switch to the instrument panel trim plate, ensuring that the locking tabs are properly seated. 4. Install the I/P accessory trim plate. Page 6419 - A control module from another vehicle is installed. - Revised software/calibration files have been released for this vehicle. - IMPORTANT: DO NOT re-program the control module with the SAME software/calibration files that are already present in the control module. This is not an effective repair for any type of concern. Verify that the control module contains the correct software/calibration. If incorrect programming is found, reprogram the control module with the most current software/calibration. Refer to Control Module References for replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Testing for Short to Ground TESTING FOR SHORT TO GROUND NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 4. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit. With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is a short to ground in the circuit. Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2. Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). - When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. - If the DMM does not display voltage 4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is shorted. Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A DIGITAL MULTIMETER NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the powertrain control module (PCM), should only be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200 Digital Multimeter (DMM). The J 39200 instruction manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminage even though voltage is present. The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity. IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading. Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the measurement. Page 7059 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully raise the TPA on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA cannot be removed from the connector while there are terminals present in the connector body. View of the TPA when removed from the connector body. 4. Use the J 38125-12A tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the left side of the terminal release cavity as shown in the graphic. Use the tool to move the terminal release to the right with a gentle prying motion. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 3172 For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 7635 4. Once the front 2 locks are unlocked, lift the front of the dress cover and pull it forward. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the small slot on the TPA and pushing down until the TPA releases. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to angle or rock the J 38125-21 tool when inserting it into the connector or the tool may break. Insert the J 38125-21 (GM P/N 15381651-2) tool into the round canal between the terminals cavities at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to repair Micro 64 connector terminals. The Micro 64 connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-64 (M jaw) was developed to crimp Micro 64 terminals. The J 38125-64 crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. The J 38125-64 crimping tool is also designed to crimp both the wire and the insulation at the same time. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro 64 terminals. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. 1. Cut the wire as close to the damaged terminal as possible. 2. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. Engine - MIL ON P0116/P1400 Set In Very Cold Temps Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Customer Interest Engine - MIL ON P0116/P1400 Set In Very Cold Temps TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 10-06-04-008A Date: January 24, 2011 Subject: Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) Illuminated at Very Cold Ambient Temperatures When Using Engine Coolant Heater, DTC P0116 and/or P1400 Set (Relocate Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor and Engine Coolant Heater Cord) Models: 2006-2007 Buick Rainier 2009 Buick LaCrosse Super, Allure Super (Canada Only) 2006-2010 Cadillac Escalade 2006-2007 Chevrolet Monte Carlo 2006-2009 Chevrolet Impala SS, TrailBlazer 2006-2010 Chevrolet Avalanche, Express, Silverado Tahoe 2006-2009 GMC Envoy 2006-2010 GMC Savana, Sierra, Yukon 2006-2008 Pontiac Grand Prix 2006-2009 Saab 9-7X Equipped with V8 Engine RPO LC9, LH6, LH8, LH9, L76, LS2, LS4, LFA, LZ1, L92, L94, L9H or L20, L96, LMF, LMG, LY2, LY5, LY6 Please Refer to GMVIS Attention: To properly correct this condition, you must follow both of the procedures to relocate the ECT sensor and the engine coolant heater cord. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add cast iron block engine RPOs and to update the Warranty Information coverage period. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 10-06-04-008 (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). Condition Some customers may comment that the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) illuminates after starting the vehicle when they were using the engine coolant heater in very cold ambient temperatures. This usually occurs in a range of -23 to -40°C (-10 to -40°F) or colder. The technician may observe on a scan tool DTC P0116 and/or P1400 set as Current or in History. Cause This condition may be caused by the engine control module (ECM) determining that the ignition OFF time requirement has been met at start-up and interpreting the temperature difference between the engine coolant temperature (ECT) sensor and the intake air temperature (IAT) sensor as being outside of a calibrated range. Correction Important DO NOT replace the ECM for this condition. Relocating the ECT Sensor 1. Turn ON the ignition with the engine OFF. 2. Perform the diagnostic system check - vehicle. Refer to Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle in SI. ‹› If DTC P0116 and/or P1400 are set and the customer WAS using the engine coolant heater, proceed to Step 3. ‹› If DTC P0116 and/or P1400 are set and the customer WAS NOT using the engine coolant heater, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle in SI. 3. Turn OFF the ignition. Warning To avoid being burned, do not remove the radiator cap or surge tank cap while the engine is hot. The cooling system will release scalding fluid and steam Page 1710 Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. For connectors with a bolt in the dress cover, turn the bolt counterclockwise to remove the connector from the component. 2. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. Page 1370 5. Once the nose piece retainers are relaxed, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should raise slightly. 6. On the opposite side of the nose piece, use the J-38125-552 (15313892) to pull up the nose piece by hooking the tool under the nose piece and pulling up. The nose piece should release completely. If the nose piece does not come off, repeat the procedure on the opposite side. Page 902 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link). - The wire insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. 5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold them between thumb and forefinger. 7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place. - Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction. - Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip. 8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool closes.Ensure that no strands of wire are cut. 10. Crimp the splice on each end (2). Engine - Low Oil Lamp ON/Oil Leaks Oil Pressure Sensor: Customer Interest Engine - Low Oil Lamp ON/Oil Leaks TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 07-06-01-004A Date: November 25, 2008 Subject: All Vortec(R) GEN IV V8 Engines - LY2 LS4 LC9 LH6 LMG LY5 LS2 L76 LY6 L92 LS7, Low Oil Level Indicator Lamp On and/or Engine Oil Leak (Reseal Oil Pressure Sensor) Models Supercede: This bulletin is being updated to include a labor operation number for CTS-V and Corvette models. Please discard Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 07-06-01-004 (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System). Condition Some customers may comment on a low oil level indicator lamp on and/or engine oil leak. Upon further investigation, the technician may find that the oil leak is at the oil pressure sensor that is threaded into the valve lifter oil manifold (VLOM) assembly and/or engine valley cover. Correction If the engine oil leak was found to be at the engine oil pressure sensor, then remove the oil pressure sensor and reseal with a pipe sealant with Teflon or equivalent, P/N 12346004 (in Canada, P/N 10953480). Refer to Engine Oil Pressure Sensor and/or Switch Replacement in SI. Parts Information Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models) For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models) Page 3050 3. Install the 0.471" (11.96 mm) screen in the middle of the reduced diameter point of the fitting. 4. Place the suction hose fitting or suction hose side of the manifold into the installation tool fixture J-44551-5 (3) so it is supported by the tools legs. Important: Correct placement of the J-44551-5 is critical. 5. Lubricate the A/C suction screen with the applicable refrigerant oil. 6. Align the screen (2), basket first; into the suction hose bore then hand tighten the bolt until contact is made between the hose, screen and tool. 7. Turn the bolt of the installation tool clockwise pressing the screen into the bore until the mandrel shoulder contacts the end of the hose fitting. 8. Unscrew the bolt and remove the installation tool from the hose or manifold. Important: Clean the surface to be used for attaching the label. 9. Install the J-44551-1 Suction Screen Notification Label. Page 8284 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully raise the TPA on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA cannot be removed from the connector while there are terminals present in the connector body. View of the TPA when removed from the connector body. 4. Use the J 38125-12A tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the left side of the terminal release cavity as shown in the graphic. Use the tool to move the terminal release to the right with a gentle prying motion. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 6720 7. Pressing the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool in the release cavity of the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and crimper in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (DOOR MODULE) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Side view of connector. View of top of connector. 1. Locate the assist lever and lock on the top of the connector. Fuel Pressure Gage Installation and Removal Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection Fuel Pressure Gage Installation and Removal Fuel Pressure Gage Installation and Removal Tools Required CH-48027 Digital Pressure Gage Installation Procedure Caution: Refer to Gasoline/Gasoline Vapors Caution. Caution: Remove the fuel tank cap and relieve the fuel system pressure before servicing the fuel system in order to reduce the risk of personal injury. After you relieve the fuel system pressure, a small amount of fuel may be released when servicing the fuel lines, the fuel injection pump, or the connections. In order to reduce the risk of personal injury, cover the fuel system components with a shop towel before disconnection. This will catch any fuel that may leak out. Place the towel in an approved container when the disconnection is complete. 1. Relieve the fuel system pressure. Refer to Fuel Pressure Relief. 2. Connect the CH-48027-1 (1) to the CH-48027-2 (2). 3. Remove the shop towel from around the fuel rail service port, and place in an approved gasoline container. 4. Perform any tests and/or diagnostics as needed. For the proper usage of the CH-48027 , refer to the manufacture's directions. Removal Procedure Page 6959 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the DuraSeal splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of a connector. CPAs are used in all SIR System connectors and also in some connectors of other systems. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals of a connection. TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE CLIPS IMPORTANT: When making a splice in an area that may be exposed to moisture use a crimp and seal splice sleeve instead of a Splice Clip. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves. TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. Page 4777 Checking Aftermarket Accessories CHECKING AFTERMARKET ACCESSORIES Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits: - CAUTION: Refer to Restraint System Service Precautions. SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol. - NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice. OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol. Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the cause of the problems. Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include: Power feeds connected to points other than the battery - Antenna location - Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring - Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line - Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories. Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions INDUCING INTERMITTENT FAULT CONDITIONS TOOLS REQUIRED J 25070 Heat Gun Many intermittent open or shorted circuits are affected by harness/connector movement that is caused by vibration, engine torque, bumps/rough pavement, etc. In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness if the malfunction appears to be Page 2584 - Most Molex connectors will have the Molex logo on the dresscover of the connector. In some cases the connectors may have MX followed by another letter. The third letter indicates where the connector was made. A connector with MXD is a Molex connector made in Detroit. Sumitomo has a unique symbol on their connector and possibly a part number. The symbol is similar to that of a diamond lying on its side, similar to that shown. The logo could appear anywhere but the most common place is at the wire side of the housing. Tyco/AMP has many different and unique connector designs. Some may or may not have identifiable marks on them. Page 5780 1. Locate the air flow direction arrow (2) on the MAF/IAT sensor. 2. Install the MAF/IAT sensor on to the air cleaner housing. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 3. Tighten the clamp securing the MAF/IAT sensor to the air cleaner housing. Tighten the clamp to 7 N.m (62 lb in). 4. Install the air cleaner outlet duct. 5. Install the air cleaner outlet duct bolt. Tighten the bolt to 10 N.m (89 lb in). 6. Tighten the clamps at the MAF/IAT sensor and the throttle body. Tighten the clamps to 7 N.m (62 lb in). Page 8250 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Bosch Connectors (BSK) BOSCH CONNECTORS (BSK) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 3. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 4. Insert the J 38125-561 tool into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 5. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is Engine - MIL ON P0116/P1400 Set In Very Cold Temps Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Customer Interest Engine - MIL ON P0116/P1400 Set In Very Cold Temps TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 10-06-04-008A Date: January 24, 2011 Subject: Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) Illuminated at Very Cold Ambient Temperatures When Using Engine Coolant Heater, DTC P0116 and/or P1400 Set (Relocate Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor and Engine Coolant Heater Cord) Models: 2006-2007 Buick Rainier 2009 Buick LaCrosse Super, Allure Super (Canada Only) 2006-2010 Cadillac Escalade 2006-2007 Chevrolet Monte Carlo 2006-2009 Chevrolet Impala SS, TrailBlazer 2006-2010 Chevrolet Avalanche, Express, Silverado Tahoe 2006-2009 GMC Envoy 2006-2010 GMC Savana, Sierra, Yukon 2006-2008 Pontiac Grand Prix 2006-2009 Saab 9-7X Equipped with V8 Engine RPO LC9, LH6, LH8, LH9, L76, LS2, LS4, LFA, LZ1, L92, L94, L9H or L20, L96, LMF, LMG, LY2, LY5, LY6 Please Refer to GMVIS Attention: To properly correct this condition, you must follow both of the procedures to relocate the ECT sensor and the engine coolant heater cord. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add cast iron block engine RPOs and to update the Warranty Information coverage period. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 10-06-04-008 (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). Condition Some customers may comment that the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) illuminates after starting the vehicle when they were using the engine coolant heater in very cold ambient temperatures. This usually occurs in a range of -23 to -40°C (-10 to -40°F) or colder. The technician may observe on a scan tool DTC P0116 and/or P1400 set as Current or in History. Cause This condition may be caused by the engine control module (ECM) determining that the ignition OFF time requirement has been met at start-up and interpreting the temperature difference between the engine coolant temperature (ECT) sensor and the intake air temperature (IAT) sensor as being outside of a calibrated range. Correction Important DO NOT replace the ECM for this condition. Relocating the ECT Sensor 1. Turn ON the ignition with the engine OFF. 2. Perform the diagnostic system check - vehicle. Refer to Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle in SI. ‹› If DTC P0116 and/or P1400 are set and the customer WAS using the engine coolant heater, proceed to Step 3. ‹› If DTC P0116 and/or P1400 are set and the customer WAS NOT using the engine coolant heater, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle in SI. 3. Turn OFF the ignition. Warning To avoid being burned, do not remove the radiator cap or surge tank cap while the engine is hot. The cooling system will release scalding fluid and steam Page 2480 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry one side of the nose piece up to the pre-stage position. When the nose piece is in the pre-staged position, the nose piece will be raised above the connector body the length of the step in the nose piece. 7. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry the other side of the piece to the pre-stage position. If the nose piece is higher than the first step in the nose piece, gently push down on the nose piece until it meets with resistance from the connector body, you should feel the nose piece click into position. Fuel Level Sensor Replacement Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair Fuel Level Sensor Replacement Fuel Level Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Remove the fuel sender assembly. 2. Disconnect the fuel level sensor electrical connector (1). 3. Depress the fuel level sensor retaining tabs (2) to release the sensor from the sender assembly. 4. Remove the fuel level sensor electrical connector (1) and sensor (2) from the fuel sender assembly. Installation Procedure Page 5052 Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 1. Install the exhaust manifold heat shield with the 4 nuts. Tighten the exhaust manifold heat shield nuts to 10 N.m (89 lb in). 2. Install the oxygen sensor. Refer to Heated Oxygen Sensor 1 Replacement. 3. Install the oil level indicator. Refer to Oil Level Indicator and Tube Replacement. 4. Move the transmission filler tube back onto the stud and secure the tube with the nut. Tighten the transmission filler tube bracket nut to 10 N.m (89 lb in). 5. Install the air cleaner outlet resonator. Refer to Air Cleaner Outlet Resonator Replacement. Page 5171 11. Insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) into the 2 triangular cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 12. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE 1. Prior to installation the terminal must be aligned so the (1) coding lugs align with the (2) coding grooves on the connector. 2. Once the terminal is aligned, slide the terminal into the cavity until the retainer has engaged in the cavity of the connector. 3. Slide the TPA in the connector body and seat it using a small flat bladed tool. The TPA is seated when it is flush with the contact housing. 4. Secure the wires to the connector body using a tie wrap and replace the dress cover and grommet. Bosch Connectors (2.8 JPT) BOSCH CONNECTORS (2.8 JPT) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Pull out the slider on the connector position assurance (CPA) until it is at the end of its travel. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Remove the wire dress cover, if necessary. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 1306 Utility/Van Zoning UTILITY/VAN ZONING Page 7665 9. The illustration shows a cutaway view of the connector to aid the technician in releasing the terminal retainer. 10. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Terminal Position Assurance Locks TERMINAL POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement. Tyco/Amp Connectors (CM 42-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (CM 42-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the connector body and pull the CPA out. The CPA is on the wire harness side of connector. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 6118 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. 4. Remove the dress cover by using a flat bladed tool to release the dress cover locking tabs and lift up on the dress cover. 5. Cut the tie wrap that holds the wires to the connector body. Page 6295 Utility/Van Zoning UTILITY/VAN ZONING Page 7829 If a wire is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm, etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except coaxial. - Do not use the DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent American wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 4540 4. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the rear of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. 5. Once the locking tabs are unlocked, slide the inner connector out of the rear of the connector housing. Page 1395 If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the DuraSeal splice sleeves. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: - Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. - Do not use the crimp and DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 to crimp DuraSeal splice sleeve. In order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 8316 The engine harness may be repaired using the J-38125. High Temperature Wiring Repairs HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperatures, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time may use materials i.e. wires, connectors, and shielding that has a higher heat rating than typical wiring. When making a repair in a high temperature area observe the following: Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature to replace any damaged wire. - Replace any heat shielding that is removed. - Cover any DuraSeal splice sleeves with SCT1 shrink tubing (available in the J-38125 Terminal Repair kit). - After making a wiring repair, ensure that the location of the wiring is not moved closer to the heat source. IDENTIFYING HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperature, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time need special considerations when making wiring repairs. Areas that may be exposed to higher temperatures can be identified by heat resistant materials that are being used in those areas. These materials may include heat reflective tape, moon tape, and high temperature shrink tubing. Also conduit and other protective coverings may be used. Because conduit or similar coverings are used throughout the vehicle regardless of the temperature, it may be necessary for the technician to determine if an area is exposed to excessive heat before making a wiring repair. Obvious areas of consideration would be any area located near the exhaust manifolds, catalytic converter, and exhaust pipes. The J-38125 contains much of the material you will need to perform repairs on areas exposed to high heat. The kit contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves to crimp and seal connections - High temperature SCT1 shrink tubing to protect the splice sleeves - A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct crimp tool to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools to remove the terminals from the connectors The J-38125 does not contain wire that is suitable to high temperature exposure. Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature of the same or larger gage size as the original wire when repair damage wire. Also replace any reflective tape that you remove during the repair. HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature rating of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125 and then encapsulate the splice sleeve using the high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the order listed. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip keeping all of the wire strands intact. Page 537 View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. View of the release tool being used for the smaller terminals. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (2-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 7747 All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system. Page 5961 - Kostel - Molex - Sumitomo - Tyco/AMP - Yazaki Identifying the manufacturer of a connector is often difficult. When trying to determine the manufacturer of a connector, look for specific identifying marks that are unique to that connector supplier. Most of these identify marks are hard to find or see. Check the connector carefully and refer to the information below for pictures and descriptions of connector identification markings. - Most of AFLs connectors have EPC on their connector body. Some of the smaller connectors will not have any markings on them. - In some cases Bosch will actually be printed on the connector. If Bosch does not appear on the connector, look for the Bosch logo. The Bosch logo is a circle with a blunted arrow inside. This logo can appear anywhere on the connector and is often very small. Page 6136 TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert a small flat-blade tool in the slot below the front loaded terminal position assurance (TPA) and pry up. 3. Remove the TPA by pulling it out of the connector. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-553 (GM P/N 15315247) on a slight upward angle into the cavity below the terminal to be removed. Ensure that the pointed on the end of the tool is facing the bottom of the terminal and it stays in contact with the terminal until it stops on the plastic terminal retainer. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 2012 2. Locate the two indents of the terminal position assurance (TPA) located on the bottom of the connector body. Page 6590 6. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by pressing on the tang. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (SENSOR) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) tool into the cavity on the lower right hand face of the connector until the terminal release tang access panel slides over. Page 4590 to analyze the data during the time a vehicle condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a trigger point that you have determined. Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2 snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a first-in, first-out basis. If a third snapshot is taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost. Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types: Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice - Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200 frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not lost if the Scan Tool is powered down. The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis. The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected values by plotting 3 parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful, especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC. Testing for a Short to Voltage TESTING FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4. Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt, there is a short to voltage in the circuit. Testing for Continuity TESTING FOR CONTINUITY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6. Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit. 7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity. With a Test Lamp IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits. 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6. If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity. Testing for Electrical Intermittents TESTING FOR ELECTRICAL INTERMITTENTS Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment. - Testing for Short to Ground - Testing for Continuity - Testing for a Short to Voltage Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON Air Filter Element: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-013B Date: February 01, 2007 INFORMATION Subject: Automatic Transmission Shift, Engine Driveability Concerns or Service Engine Soon (SES) Light On as a Result of the Use of an Excessively/Over-Oiled Aftermarket, Reusable Air Filter Models: 2007 and Prior GM Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2007 and Prior Saturn Models 2003-2007 HUMMER H2 2006-2007 HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 04-07-30-013A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle). The use of an excessively/over-oiled aftermarket, reusable air filter may result in: Service Engine Soon (SES) light on Transmission shift concerns, slipping and damaged clutch(es) or band(s) Engine driveability concerns, poor acceleration from a stop, limited engine RPM range The oil that is used on these air filter elements may be transferred onto the Mass Air Flow (MAF) sensor causing contamination of the sensor. As a result, the Grams per Second (GPS) signal from the MAF may be low and any or all of the concerns listed above may occur. When servicing a vehicle with any of these concerns, be sure to check for the presence of an aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter. The MAF, GPS reading should be compared to a like vehicle with an OEM air box and filter under the same driving conditions to verify the concern. The use of an aftermarket reusable air filter DOES NOT void the vehicle's warranty. If an aftermarket reusable air filter is used, technicians should inspect the MAF sensor element and the air induction hose for contamination of oil prior to making warranty repairs. Transmission or engine driveability concerns (related to the MAF sensor being contaminated with oil) that are the result of the use of an aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter are not considered to be warrantable repair items. Page 6499 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches, and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original. - The wires insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the possibility of fuel contact. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1). 5. Select the proper duraseal splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool. Refer to the Crimp and Seal Splice Table. 6. Place the duraseal splice sleeve in the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115) crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 7. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to hold the duraseal splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 8. Insert the wires into the duraseal splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel in order to prevent the wire from passing through the splice (3). 9. Close the handles of the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115), until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is applied to the splice sleeve. 10. Shrink the insulation around the splice. - Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. - Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Splicing Inline Harness Diodes SPLICING INLINE HARNESS DIODES Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure. 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode. 2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool. 5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode. Page 1643 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Start in the middle and gradually move the heat barrel to the open ends of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Heated Oxygen Sensor Wiring Repairs HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being obstructed. If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. - Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks, etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire. - Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance. - To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector. Page 5074 Body Control Module (BCM) C3 Page 1278 Turn Signal/Multifunction Switch C4 (With RPO Code K34) Page 7458 Liftgate Page 3714 Page 1889 View of typical connector. View of connector in released position. 1. Locate the assist lever at the back of the connector. Move the assist lever to the rear position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the dress cover. Page 8974 If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs SIR/SRS WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS, and the wiring components, such as connectors and terminals. IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system terminals. Use either an SIR/SRS pigtail or a terminated lead from the SIR Repair Kit Tray. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves, in order to repair the SIR/SRS wiring - A special crimping tool - A heat torch - An instruction manual The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides the necessary low resistance contact integrity for these sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors SIR/SRS CONNECTOR REPAIR (PLASTIC BODY AND TERMINAL METAL PIN) The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made with a special plating. This plating provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. Use the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit for repairing SIR/SRS terminals and connectors. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the repair kit. The J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit contains: Various terminated leads for sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) terminal replacement - Various connector positive assurance (CPA) locks for SIR/SRS connectors - Base of steering column pigtail connectors part number 12085514 - Yellow vinyl electrical tape Pigtail repair packs are available for SIR/SRS connectors with eight or less terminals. Only the connector body is available for connectors with more than eight terminals. The terminated leads in the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit can be used to replace damaged terminals when replacing the connector body. SIR/SRS COMPONENT WIRE PIGTAIL REPAIR IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails. A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device, not by a connector. If a wiring pigtail is damaged, you must replace the entire component, with pigtail. The inflatable restraint steering wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component. SIR/SRS WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 7564 Page 1787 11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the solder equipment. 12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. 13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to cover the first piece of tape. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE SLEEVES TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit IMPORTANT: Use only dura seal splice sleeves. Other splice sleeves may not protect the splice from moisture or provide a good electrical connection. Use duraseal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. Use duraseal splice sleeves where there is special requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire using duraseal splice sleeves. Page 259 11. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 12. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 13. Center the high temperature SCT1 shrink tube over the DuraSeal splice sleeve. 14. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the high temperature heat shrink tubing. 15. Gradually move the heat from the center to the open end of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. 16. Replace any reflective tape and clips that may have been remove during the repair. Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation REPAIRING DAMAGED WIRE INSULATION Wire Size Conversion Page 6613 6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias. Reference the appropriate service manual wiring schematic to obtain the correct diode installation position. 7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for the soldering equipment. 8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed. 9. IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode attachment points with tape. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape. Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable SPLICING TWISTED OR SHIELDED CABLE Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable. 1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splice is made. 3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire. Staggering the splices by 65 mm (2.5 in) is recommended. 4. IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical contact with the drain wire. Re-assemble the cable. Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape. - Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1). - Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire. - Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape. Page 6846 1. Correctly position the spark plug washer. 2. Inspect the spark plug gap. Adjust the gap as needed. Spark plug gap: 1.524 mm (0.06 in) 3. Hand start the spark plug in the corresponding cylinder. Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice. 4. Tighten the spark plug. * For used heads, tighten the plug to 15 N.m (11 lb ft). * For NEW heads, tighten the plug to 20 N.m (15 lb ft). 5. Install the spark plug wire. 6. If removed, install the washer solvent container. Page 8956 4. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the rear of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs. Repeat this procedure for the other locking tab. 5. Once the locking tabs are unlocked, slide the inner connector out of the rear of the connector housing. Page 180 IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals. Front probe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the connector. IMPORTANT: When probing female 0.64 terminals, it is important to use the correct adapter. There have been some revisions to the test adapter for 0.64 terminals. The proper adapter for 0.64 terminals is the J 35616-64B which has a gold terminal and a black wire between the base and tip. Failure to use the proper test adapter may result in damage to the terminal being tested and improper diagnosis. NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Page 4159 For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 1734 2. Locate the nose piece locking tabs that are positioned on the side of the connector nose piece. The connector nose piece acts as a terminal positive assurance (TPA) and may be referred to as such. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to push in one of the locking tabs while gently pulling on the same side of the nose piece. 4. Repeat the procedure for the other locking tab and remove the nose piece. 5. Remove the wire dress cover. The following is a general procedure for wire dress cover removal. Use this procedure as a guide, some dress cover removal procedures may vary. 6. Use fingers to squeeze the 2 locking legs of the cover. Page 1391 The engine harness may be repaired using the J-38125. High Temperature Wiring Repairs HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperatures, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time may use materials i.e. wires, connectors, and shielding that has a higher heat rating than typical wiring. When making a repair in a high temperature area observe the following: Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature to replace any damaged wire. - Replace any heat shielding that is removed. - Cover any DuraSeal splice sleeves with SCT1 shrink tubing (available in the J-38125 Terminal Repair kit). - After making a wiring repair, ensure that the location of the wiring is not moved closer to the heat source. IDENTIFYING HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRING Wiring that is exposed to high temperature, 135°C (275°F) or higher, for prolonged periods of time need special considerations when making wiring repairs. Areas that may be exposed to higher temperatures can be identified by heat resistant materials that are being used in those areas. These materials may include heat reflective tape, moon tape, and high temperature shrink tubing. Also conduit and other protective coverings may be used. Because conduit or similar coverings are used throughout the vehicle regardless of the temperature, it may be necessary for the technician to determine if an area is exposed to excessive heat before making a wiring repair. Obvious areas of consideration would be any area located near the exhaust manifolds, catalytic converter, and exhaust pipes. The J-38125 contains much of the material you will need to perform repairs on areas exposed to high heat. The kit contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves to crimp and seal connections - High temperature SCT1 shrink tubing to protect the splice sleeves - A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct crimp tool to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools to remove the terminals from the connectors The J-38125 does not contain wire that is suitable to high temperature exposure. Use high temperature bulk wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature of the same or larger gage size as the original wire when repair damage wire. Also replace any reflective tape that you remove during the repair. HIGH TEMPERATURE WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire rated at 150°C (302°F) continuous temperature rating of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125 and then encapsulate the splice sleeve using the high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the order listed. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip keeping all of the wire strands intact. Page 3055 Power Steering Line/Hose: Service and Repair Power Steering Gear Inlet and Outlet Hose Replacement (Except 4.2L) Tools Required J 44586 Power Steering Gear Oil Seal Remover/Installer Removal Procedure 1. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. Notice: Refer to Power Steering Hose Disconnected Notice. 2. Install the drain pan under the vehicle. 3. Remove power steering hose assembly to power steering gear mounting bolt (2). 4. Disconnect the power steering hose assembly (1) from the power steering gear (3). 5. Disconnect the power steering return hose and power steering cooler hose from the power steering cooler. 6. Lower the vehicle. Page 1369 3. Remove the dress cover by using a flat-blade tool to release the connector locking tabs and pulling off the dress cover. 4. Relieve the tension on the nose piece retainers by inserting J-38125-12A (12094429) into the single retainer slot on the end of the nose piece and gently prying out the locking tab. Repeat the process for both of the nose piece locking tabs on the opposite side of the nose piece. Page 550 If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the DuraSeal splice sleeves. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: - Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. - Do not use the crimp and DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 to crimp DuraSeal splice sleeve. In order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 175 Page 7018 It is very important to use the correct test adapter when testing for proper terminal contact of fuses and relays in a bussed electrical center (BEC). Use J-35616-35 to test for proper terminal contact. Failure to use J-35616-35 can result in improper diagnosis of the BEC. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Separate the connector halves. 2. Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body. 3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J-38125 , test that the retention force is significantly different between a good terminal and a suspect terminal. Replace the female terminal in question. FLAT WIRE (DOCK AND LOCK) CONNECTORS There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock) connectors on the harness side or the component side. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Remove the component in question. 2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side of the connector as oil from your skin may be a source of contamination as well. 3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other imperfections that could cause poor terminal contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are uniform and free of damage or deformation. 4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the on the flat wire harness connector in order to test the circuit in question. CONTROL MODULE/COMPONENT VOLTAGE AND GROUNDS Poor voltage or ground connections can cause widely varying symptoms. Test all control module voltage supply circuits. Many vehicles have multiple circuits supplying voltage to a control module. Other components in the system may have separate voltage supply circuits that may also need to be tested. Inspect connections at the module/component connectors, fuses, and any intermediate connections between the voltage source and the module/component. A test lamp or a DMM may indicate that voltage is present, but neither tests the ability of the circuit to carry sufficient current. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Power Distribution Schematics. - Test all control module ground and system ground circuits. The control module may have multiple ground circuits. Other components in the system may have separate grounds that may also need to be tested. Inspect grounds for clean and tight connections at the grounding point. Inspect the connections at the component and in splice packs, where applicable. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Ground Distribution Schematics. TEMPERATURE SENSITIVITY - An intermittent condition may occur when a component/connection reaches normal operating temperature. The condition may occur only when the component/connection is cold, or only when the component/connection is hot. - Freeze Frame, Failure Records, Snapshot, or Vehicle Data Recorder data may help with this type of intermittent condition, where applicable. - If the intermittent is related to heat, review the data for a relationship with the following: High ambient temperatures - Underhood/engine generated heat - Circuit generated heat due to a poor connection, or high electrical load - Higher than normal load conditions, towing, etc. - If the intermittent is related to cold, review the data for the following: Low ambient temperatures-In extremely low temperatures, ice may form in a connection or component. Inspect for water intrusion. - The condition only occurs on a cold start. - The condition goes away when the vehicle warms up. - Information from the customer may help to determine if the trouble follows a pattern that is temperature related. - If temperature is suspected of causing an intermittent fault condition, attempt to duplicate the condition. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required. ELECTROMAGNETIC INTERFERENCE (EMI) AND ELECTRICAL NOISE Some electrical components/circuits are sensitive to electromagnetic interference (EMI) or other types of electrical noise. Inspect for the following conditions: A misrouted harness that is too close to high voltage/high current devices such as secondary ignition components, motors, generator etc-These components may induce electrical noise on a circuit that could interfere with normal circuit operation. - Electrical system interference caused by a malfunctioning relay, or a control module driven solenoid or switch-These conditions can cause a sharp electrical surge. Normally, the condition will occur when the malfunctioning component is operating. - Improper installation of non-factory or aftermarket add on accessories such as lights, 2-way radios, amplifiers, electric motors, remote starters, alarm systems, cell phones, etc-These accessories may lead to interference while in use, but do not fail when the accessories are not in use. - Test for an open diode across the A/C compressor clutch and for other open diodes. Some relays may contain a clamping diode. - The generator may be allowing AC noise into the electrical system. INCORRECT CONTROL MODULE - There are only a few situations where reprogramming a control module is appropriate: A new service control module is installed. Page 6279 Page 6290 Page 6686 View of the connector when released from the component. View of another type of Micro 64 connector. Page 8845 5. While pushing the terminal forward, insert the J 38125-24 in the release cavity above the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (43-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Page 7055 REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. The release tab is located on the top of the wiredress cover. View of connector in released position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Page 363 It is very important to use the correct test adapter when testing for proper terminal contact of fuses and relays in a bussed electrical center (BEC). Use J-35616-35 to test for proper terminal contact. Failure to use J-35616-35 can result in improper diagnosis of the BEC. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Separate the connector halves. 2. Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body. 3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J-38125 , test that the retention force is significantly different between a good terminal and a suspect terminal. Replace the female terminal in question. FLAT WIRE (DOCK AND LOCK) CONNECTORS There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock) connectors on the harness side or the component side. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Remove the component in question. 2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side of the connector as oil from your skin may be a source of contamination as well. 3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other imperfections that could cause poor terminal contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are uniform and free of damage or deformation. 4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the on the flat wire harness connector in order to test the circuit in question. CONTROL MODULE/COMPONENT VOLTAGE AND GROUNDS Poor voltage or ground connections can cause widely varying symptoms. Test all control module voltage supply circuits. Many vehicles have multiple circuits supplying voltage to a control module. Other components in the system may have separate voltage supply circuits that may also need to be tested. Inspect connections at the module/component connectors, fuses, and any intermediate connections between the voltage source and the module/component. A test lamp or a DMM may indicate that voltage is present, but neither tests the ability of the circuit to carry sufficient current. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Power Distribution Schematics. - Test all control module ground and system ground circuits. The control module may have multiple ground circuits. Other components in the system may have separate grounds that may also need to be tested. Inspect grounds for clean and tight connections at the grounding point. Inspect the connections at the component and in splice packs, where applicable. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Ground Distribution Schematics. TEMPERATURE SENSITIVITY - An intermittent condition may occur when a component/connection reaches normal operating temperature. The condition may occur only when the component/connection is cold, or only when the component/connection is hot. - Freeze Frame, Failure Records, Snapshot, or Vehicle Data Recorder data may help with this type of intermittent condition, where applicable. - If the intermittent is related to heat, review the data for a relationship with the following: High ambient temperatures - Underhood/engine generated heat - Circuit generated heat due to a poor connection, or high electrical load - Higher than normal load conditions, towing, etc. - If the intermittent is related to cold, review the data for the following: Low ambient temperatures-In extremely low temperatures, ice may form in a connection or component. Inspect for water intrusion. - The condition only occurs on a cold start. - The condition goes away when the vehicle warms up. - Information from the customer may help to determine if the trouble follows a pattern that is temperature related. - If temperature is suspected of causing an intermittent fault condition, attempt to duplicate the condition. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required. ELECTROMAGNETIC INTERFERENCE (EMI) AND ELECTRICAL NOISE Some electrical components/circuits are sensitive to electromagnetic interference (EMI) or other types of electrical noise. Inspect for the following conditions: A misrouted harness that is too close to high voltage/high current devices such as secondary ignition components, motors, generator etc-These components may induce electrical noise on a circuit that could interfere with normal circuit operation. - Electrical system interference caused by a malfunctioning relay, or a control module driven solenoid or switch-These conditions can cause a sharp electrical surge. Normally, the condition will occur when the malfunctioning component is operating. - Improper installation of non-factory or aftermarket add on accessories such as lights, 2-way radios, amplifiers, electric motors, remote starters, alarm systems, cell phones, etc-These accessories may lead to interference while in use, but do not fail when the accessories are not in use. - Test for an open diode across the A/C compressor clutch and for other open diodes. Some relays may contain a clamping diode. - The generator may be allowing AC noise into the electrical system. INCORRECT CONTROL MODULE - There are only a few situations where reprogramming a control module is appropriate: A new service control module is installed. Diagrams Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Diagrams Engine Controls Connector End Views Mass Air Flow (MAF)/Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor Page 2315 IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals. Front probe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the connector. IMPORTANT: When probing female 0.64 terminals, it is important to use the correct adapter. There have been some revisions to the test adapter for 0.64 terminals. The proper adapter for 0.64 terminals is the J 35616-64B which has a gold terminal and a black wire between the base and tip. Failure to use the proper test adapter may result in damage to the terminal being tested and improper diagnosis. NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Page 471 to analyze the data during the time a vehicle condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a trigger point that you have determined. Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2 snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a first-in, first-out basis. If a third snapshot is taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost. Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types: Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice - Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200 frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not lost if the Scan Tool is powered down. The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis. The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected values by plotting 3 parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful, especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC. Testing for a Short to Voltage TESTING FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4. Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt, there is a short to voltage in the circuit. Testing for Continuity TESTING FOR CONTINUITY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6. Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit. 7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity. With a Test Lamp IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits. 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6. If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity. Testing for Electrical Intermittents TESTING FOR ELECTRICAL INTERMITTENTS Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment. - Testing for Short to Ground - Testing for Continuity - Testing for a Short to Voltage Page 848 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert terminal into the appropriate terminal holder until it hits bottom and stops. The correct terminal holder is determined by the wire size. Also ensure that the terminals wings are pointing towards the former on the tool and the release locator. 5. Insert the stripped cable into the terminal. Insulation should be visible on both sides of the terminal insulation wings. 6. Compress the handles until the ratchet automatically releases. 7. Place the terminal into the appropriate cavity and assemble the connector. Delphi Connectors (Micro-Pack 100W) DELPHI CONNECTORS (MICRO-PACK 100W) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE There are 2 styles of Micro-Pack 100W connectors. These connectors are very similar but use different terminals and have some minor physical differences also. Brakes - ABS Lamp ON/DTC's C0265/C0201/U1041 Set Grounding Point: All Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - ABS Lamp ON/DTC's C0265/C0201/U1041 Set TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 04-05-25-002E Date: March 11, 2009 Subject: ABS Light On, DTCs C0265, C0201, U1041 Set and/or Loss of Communication with Brake Module (Reground EBCM Ground) Models Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add step 2 to the procedure and update the Parts and Warranty Information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 04-05-25-002D (Section 05 - Brakes). Condition Some customers may comment that the ABS light is on. Upon further inspection, DTCs C0265 and C0201 may be set in the brake module. It is also possible for DTC U1041 to set in other modules. There may also be a loss of communication with the brake module. Cause A poor connection at the EBCM ground is causing unnecessary replacement of brake modules. Important: The EBCM ground is different for each application. Refer to the list below for the proper ground reference: ^ Midsize Utilities = Ground 304 ^ SSR = Ground 400 ^ Fullsize Trucks and Utilities = Ground 110 Correction Important: Do not replace the brake module to correct this condition. Perform the following repair before further diagnosis of the EBCM. Perform the following steps to improve the connection of the EBCM Ground: 1. Remove the EBCM Ground. The EBCM Ground is located on the frame beneath the driver's side door. If multiple grounds are found in this location, the EBCM ground can be identified as the heavy (12-gauge) wire. 2. If the original fastener has a welded on nut, remove the nut from the frame, and if required, enlarge the bolt hole to accommodate the new bolt and nut. 3. Clean the area, front and back, using a tool such as a *3M(TM) Scotch-Brite Roloc disc or equivalent. Page 7141 Page 308 5. Install the nuts which retain the seat pan to the seat assembly. Tighten the nuts to 25 N.m (18 lb ft). 6. Install the 3 seat switch bezel screws. 7. Calibrate the seat. Refer to Memory Seat Calibration. Page 7633 View of the connector when released from the component. View of another type of Micro 64 connector. Page 4588 IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals. Front probe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the connector. IMPORTANT: When probing female 0.64 terminals, it is important to use the correct adapter. There have been some revisions to the test adapter for 0.64 terminals. The proper adapter for 0.64 terminals is the J 35616-64B which has a gold terminal and a black wire between the base and tip. Failure to use the proper test adapter may result in damage to the terminal being tested and improper diagnosis. NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes (DVOM etc.) into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal will cause a poor connection, which will result in a system failure. Always use the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit in order to front probe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other substitutes to probe terminals. When using the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit, ensure the terminal test adapter choice is the correct size for the connector terminal. Do not visually choose the terminal test adapter because some connector terminal cavities may appear larger than the actual terminal in the cavity. Using a larger terminal test adapter will damage the terminal. Refer to the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit label on the inside of the J-35616 GM-Approved Terminal Test Kit for the correct adapter along with the connector end view for terminal size. Page 5217 6. Use the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool to release the terminals by pressing on the tang. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Sensor) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (SENSOR) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component. 2. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) tool into the cavity on the lower right hand face of the connector until the terminal release tang access panel slides over. Page 8491 Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Mass Airflow Sensor/Intake Air Temperature Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure Important: Use care when handling the mass air flow (MAF)/intake air temperature (IAT) sensor. Do not dent, puncture, or otherwise damage the honeycell located at the air inlet end of the MAF/IAT. Do not touch the sensing elements or allow anything including cleaning solvents and lubricants to come in contact with them. Use a small amount of a non-silicone based lubricant, on the air duct only, to aid in installation. 1. Disconnect the MAF/IAT sensor electrical connector. 2. Loosen the clamps at the MAF/IAT sensor and the throttle body. 3. Remove the air cleaner outlet duct bolt. 4. Remove the air cleaner outlet duct. 5. Loosen the clamp attaching the MAF/IAT sensor to the air cleaner housing. 6. Remove the MAF/IAT sensor from the air cleaner housing. Installation Procedure Important: The embossed arrow on the MAF/IAT sensor indicates the proper air flow direction. The arrow must point toward the engine. Page 5237 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link). - The wire insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. 5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold them between thumb and forefinger. 7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place. - Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction. - Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip. 8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool closes.Ensure that no strands of wire are cut. 10. Crimp the splice on each end (2). Page 2029 2. While depressing the lock, pull the lever over and past the lock. 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. OnStar(R) - Availability for Hearing Impaired Communications Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Availability for Hearing Impaired INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 06-08-46-005B Date: February 11, 2010 Subject: Availability of OnStar(R) for Hearing Impaired Models: 2007-2010 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Including Saturn and Saab) Except 2007 Cadillac CTS Except 2007-2008 HUMMER H2, H2 SUT Except 2007 Pontiac Montana SV6 Except 2007-2010 Pontiac Vibe Except 2007 Saturn ION, VUE Except 2008 Saturn Astra Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add a Note regarding 2009 Bluetooth(R)-equipped vehicles, additional models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 06-08-46-005A (Section 08 - Body and Accessories). Important This service bulletin is not applicable to 'GM of Canada' dealers and retailers. Note On 2009 and newer model year vehicles equipped with the Bluetooth(R) feature (option code UPF), when up-fitted with TTY capabilities, the Bluetooth(R) feature will be disabled. OnStar with Text Telephone Capability (TTY) General Motors is pleased to announce that the safety and security of OnStar is now available to our deaf, hard of hearing and speech impaired customers. The current vehicles listed above, as well as forthcoming vehicles equipped with OnStar hardware version 7.0 or higher, have the ability to utilize texting telephones. Vehicle specific TTY capability can be determined by utilizing the VIN lookup Tool. Additional information may be found by referring to www.onstar.com/tty. TTY equipment allows people who are deaf, hard of hearing or speech impaired, in-vehicle access to 911 and basic OnStar(R) services by pressing the OnStar(R) blue button or red emergency button. The keypad provides a means to communicate by allowing customers to type messages back and forth, with an OnStar(R) advisor or other party when using the OnStar(R) Hands-Free Calling feature. A TTY is required at both ends of the conversation in order to communicate. OnStar(R) Turn by Turn Navigation and Virtual Advisor are not available with the addition of TTY. The Reimbursement Program This equipment will be made available to eligible customers through GM Mobility and OnStar(R). Under this program, the customer must complete a GM Mobility application form. To take advantage of the program, vehicles must be adapted at the time of delivery for purchase / lease and a dealer claim ($1,000 Maximum per GM Mobility guidelines) with the application form submitted to GM Mobility. Saab dealers must fax documents. GM Dealers will receive electronic reimbursement directly from GM Mobility. Saab dealers will receive a check directly from OnStar(R). Additional questions or concerns should be directed to the OnStar Dealer Center. How to Order To order the dealer installed kit, contact AutoCraft Electronics or via the web at www.autocraft.com. The kit consists of an OnStar Interface Module, a Dial Pad (for making calls), OTIM wiring harness, the TTY device, installation/Tech 2(R) programming instructions and owner's guide. Warranty Information The Ultra-Tec Compact C TTY device is manufactured by an independent manufacturer and is covered by the manufacturer's warranty. It is not covered under the GM New Vehicle Limited Warranty. All other parts (OTIM, dial pad and OTIM wiring harness) are covered by the standard GM new vehicle parts and labor warranty. Replacement parts are available through AutoCraft Electronics. Contact AutoCraft Electronics or via the web. Warranty claims for the OTIM, dial pad and OTIM wiring harness should be submitted through normal warranty procedures using a sublet warranty claim with GM Labor Operation R5140. Page 823 It is very important to use the correct test adapter when testing for proper terminal contact of fuses and relays in a bussed electrical center (BEC). Use J-35616-35 to test for proper terminal contact. Failure to use J-35616-35 can result in improper diagnosis of the BEC. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Separate the connector halves. 2. Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body. 3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J-38125 , test that the retention force is significantly different between a good terminal and a suspect terminal. Replace the female terminal in question. FLAT WIRE (DOCK AND LOCK) CONNECTORS There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock) connectors on the harness side or the component side. Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact: 1. Remove the component in question. 2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side of the connector as oil from your skin may be a source of contamination as well. 3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other imperfections that could cause poor terminal contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are uniform and free of damage or deformation. 4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the on the flat wire harness connector in order to test the circuit in question. CONTROL MODULE/COMPONENT VOLTAGE AND GROUNDS Poor voltage or ground connections can cause widely varying symptoms. Test all control module voltage supply circuits. Many vehicles have multiple circuits supplying voltage to a control module. Other components in the system may have separate voltage supply circuits that may also need to be tested. Inspect connections at the module/component connectors, fuses, and any intermediate connections between the voltage source and the module/component. A test lamp or a DMM may indicate that voltage is present, but neither tests the ability of the circuit to carry sufficient current. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Power Distribution Schematics. - Test all control module ground and system ground circuits. The control module may have multiple ground circuits. Other components in the system may have separate grounds that may also need to be tested. Inspect grounds for clean and tight connections at the grounding point. Inspect the connections at the component and in splice packs, where applicable. Ensure that the circuit can carry the current necessary to operate the component. Refer to Circuit Testing and Ground Distribution Schematics. TEMPERATURE SENSITIVITY - An intermittent condition may occur when a component/connection reaches normal operating temperature. The condition may occur only when the component/connection is cold, or only when the component/connection is hot. - Freeze Frame, Failure Records, Snapshot, or Vehicle Data Recorder data may help with this type of intermittent condition, where applicable. - If the intermittent is related to heat, review the data for a relationship with the following: High ambient temperatures - Underhood/engine generated heat - Circuit generated heat due to a poor connection, or high electrical load - Higher than normal load conditions, towing, etc. - If the intermittent is related to cold, review the data for the following: Low ambient temperatures-In extremely low temperatures, ice may form in a connection or component. Inspect for water intrusion. - The condition only occurs on a cold start. - The condition goes away when the vehicle warms up. - Information from the customer may help to determine if the trouble follows a pattern that is temperature related. - If temperature is suspected of causing an intermittent fault condition, attempt to duplicate the condition. Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required. ELECTROMAGNETIC INTERFERENCE (EMI) AND ELECTRICAL NOISE Some electrical components/circuits are sensitive to electromagnetic interference (EMI) or other types of electrical noise. Inspect for the following conditions: A misrouted harness that is too close to high voltage/high current devices such as secondary ignition components, motors, generator etc-These components may induce electrical noise on a circuit that could interfere with normal circuit operation. - Electrical system interference caused by a malfunctioning relay, or a control module driven solenoid or switch-These conditions can cause a sharp electrical surge. Normally, the condition will occur when the malfunctioning component is operating. - Improper installation of non-factory or aftermarket add on accessories such as lights, 2-way radios, amplifiers, electric motors, remote starters, alarm systems, cell phones, etc-These accessories may lead to interference while in use, but do not fail when the accessories are not in use. - Test for an open diode across the A/C compressor clutch and for other open diodes. Some relays may contain a clamping diode. - The generator may be allowing AC noise into the electrical system. INCORRECT CONTROL MODULE - There are only a few situations where reprogramming a control module is appropriate: A new service control module is installed. Specifications Compression Check: Specifications Compression Check Start with the compression gage at zero and crank the engine through 4 compression strokes, 4 puffs. Measure the compression for each cylinder. Record the readings. If a cylinder has low compression, inject approximately 15 ml (1 tablespoon) of engine oil into the combustion chamber through the spark plug hole. Measure the compression again and record the reading. The minimum compression in any 1 cylinder should not be less than 70 percent of the highest cylinder. No cylinder should read less than 690 kPa (100 psi). For example, if the highest pressure in any 1 cylinder is 1,035 kPa (150 psi), the lowest allowable pressure for any other cylinder would be 725 kPa (105 psi). (1 035 x 70% = 725) (150 x 70% = 105). Page 3236 MEASURING FREQUENCY NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal. IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM to autorange to an appropriate range. 1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency measured. Measuring Voltage MEASURING VOLTAGE NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit. 1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods: - Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. - Turn ON the engine. - Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls. - Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested. 3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The DMM displays the voltage measured at that point. Measuring Voltage Drop MEASURING VOLTAGE DROP NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points. 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to one point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points. Probing Electrical Connectors PROBING ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS Page 7553 Open the harness by removing any tape. 2. Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. 3. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 4. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent american wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 5. Slide a section of high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing down the length of wire to be spliced. Ensure that the shrink tubing will not interfere with the splice procedure. 6. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 7. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. 8. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 9. Insert the wire into the DuraSeal splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 10. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Page 1914 View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. 4. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers CIRCUIT PROTECTION - CIRCUIT BREAKERS A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types of circuit Procedures Power Seat Control Module: Procedures MEMORY SEAT CALIBRATION The memory seat module uses position sensor inputs to establish soft stop locations for the adjuster motors several millimeters ahead of the physical limits of the adjuster assembly. After replacing a memory seat module or adjuster components, it may be necessary to reset the adjuster motor soft stop locations. When the repair procedure has been completed, operate the seat adjuster switch in every direction until the seat adjuster reaches its mechanical hard stop by repeatedly pressing and releasing the switch as necessary. Page 7551 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Start in the middle and gradually move the heat barrel to the open ends of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Heated Oxygen Sensor Wiring Repairs HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being obstructed. If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. - Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks, etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire. - Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance. - To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector. Page 130 Page 5789 Page 8210 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches, and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original. - The wires insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the possibility of fuel contact. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1). 5. Select the proper duraseal splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool. Refer to the Crimp and Seal Splice Table. 6. Place the duraseal splice sleeve in the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115) crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 7. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to hold the duraseal splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 8. Insert the wires into the duraseal splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel in order to prevent the wire from passing through the splice (3). 9. Close the handles of the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115), until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is applied to the splice sleeve. 10. Shrink the insulation around the splice. - Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. - Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Splicing Inline Harness Diodes SPLICING INLINE HARNESS DIODES Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure. 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode. 2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool. 5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode. Page 885 5. While pushing the terminal forward, insert the J 38125-24 in the release cavity above the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (43-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Page 6238 4. Slide the dress cover forward and off of the connector. 5. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front and rear of the connector. Page 1420 Utility/Van Zoning UTILITY/VAN ZONING Page 2395 If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs SIR/SRS WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS, and the wiring components, such as connectors and terminals. IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system terminals. Use either an SIR/SRS pigtail or a terminated lead from the SIR Repair Kit Tray. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items: DuraSeal splice sleeves, in order to repair the SIR/SRS wiring - A special crimping tool - A heat torch - An instruction manual The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides the necessary low resistance contact integrity for these sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors SIR/SRS CONNECTOR REPAIR (PLASTIC BODY AND TERMINAL METAL PIN) The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made with a special plating. This plating provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. Use the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit for repairing SIR/SRS terminals and connectors. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the repair kit. The J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit contains: Various terminated leads for sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) terminal replacement - Various connector positive assurance (CPA) locks for SIR/SRS connectors - Base of steering column pigtail connectors part number 12085514 - Yellow vinyl electrical tape Pigtail repair packs are available for SIR/SRS connectors with eight or less terminals. Only the connector body is available for connectors with more than eight terminals. The terminated leads in the J-38125 SIR/SRS Terminal Repair Kit can be used to replace damaged terminals when replacing the connector body. SIR/SRS COMPONENT WIRE PIGTAIL REPAIR IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails. A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device, not by a connector. If a wiring pigtail is damaged, you must replace the entire component, with pigtail. The inflatable restraint steering wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component. SIR/SRS WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 4434 2. Use a small flat-bladed tool to release the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting the tool in the small recess on the side of the connector and pushing up until the TPA releases from the connector body. The TPA should raise just slightly. Do not try to remove the TPA. IMPORTANT: The TPA on this connector cannot be removed unless the terminals are removed first. The TPA will come out of the connector body, but only slightly. When the TPA is slightly raised the terminals can be removed. Using excessive force to remove the TPA with the terminals still in the connector will damage the connector. 3. Repeat the process for the other side of the connector. 4. Ensure that the TPA is in the proper position to remove the terminals. Page 543 Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size. REPAIRING A FUSIBLE LINK IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient overload protection. Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. Flat Wire Repairs FLAT WIRE REPAIRS NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced. GMLAN Wiring Repairs GMLAN WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit The GM Local Area Network (GMLAN) System requires special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific procedures and instructions when working on GMLAN connectors and terminals. The tool kit J-38125 contains the following items in order to repair the GMLAN wiring: Dura Seal splice sleeves - A wire stripping tool - J 38125-8 Crimping Tool (GM P/N 12085115) - J 38125-5 Ultra Torch Special Tool (GM P/N 12085116) The DuraSeal splice sleeves have the following 2 critical features: A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a sealing adhesive inside. - A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. The J-38125 also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items: A large sampling of common electrical terminals - The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires - The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors GMLAN REPAIRS IMPORTANT: When making a repair to any GMLAN network, the original wire length after the repair must be the same length as before the repair. If the network is a twisted pair, the twist must be maintained after the repair is completed. GMLAN has 2 types of networks, low speed and high speed. Low speed GMLAN has a single wire and works at slow speeds. High speed GMLAN has 2 wires in a twisted pair and works at higher speeds. For more information on GMLAN, refer to Data Link Communications Description and Operation. GMLAN CONNECTOR TERMINAL REPAIR IMPORTANT: A service terminal can be used to replace damaged connector terminals for both high speed and low speed GMLAN systems. When making a connector terminal repair on a GMLAN high speed system with twisted pair wires, do not untwist the wires more than necessary to make the repair. The terminals in the GMLAN system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are available in the J-38125. If the individual terminals are damaged on any GMLAN connection, use the appropriate connector repair procedure in order to repair the terminal. GMLAN WIRE REPAIR IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity. Page 5719 8. Insert the J 38125-213 into the small terminal release hole on the nose piece and gently pull on the back of the wire. 9. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Refer to the terminal crimping procedure in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire, perform the following procedure in order to replace the terminal. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. 2. Push the terminal into the connector until it locks into place. The new terminal should be even with the other terminals. Insure that the terminal is locked in place by gently pulling on the wire. 3. To assemble the connector, reverse the connector disassembly procedure. Repairing Connector Terminals REPAIRING CONNECTOR TERMINALS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following: Push to Seat terminals - Pull to Seat terminals Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your terminal repair. The J-38125 contains further information. 1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.For cable seal terminals, remove the seal. 2. Apply the correct cable seal per gage size of the wire, if used.Slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation removal. 3. Remove the insulation. 4. For sealed terminals only, align the seal with the end of the cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal.For sealed terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal. 6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.For sealed terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable. 8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals excepting Micro-Pack 100.64 size. Soldering Micro-Pack 100 World terminals may damage the terminal. Sumitomo Connectors SUMITOMO CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 7959 For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table. Disclaimer Page 5470 7. The illustration above identifies the entry canal where the terminal release tool will be inserted, and the terminal cavity. - Terminal (1) - Entry Canal (2) 8. Insert the J-38125-553 (15315247) tool into the entry canal and pry up on the terminal retainer. The terminal retainer is a small plastic piece on the top of the terminal. The terminal retainer must be held up while the terminal is pulled out of the connector. Page 8075 US English/Metric Conversion US English/Metric Conversion Page 8174 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove the rear TPA from the connector. 7. IMPORTANT: The front TPA cannot be removed from the connector. Only move it to the release point. Use a small flat-blade tool to move the front TPA to the release position. 8. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 9. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Molex Connectors Page 5618 Camshaft Position Sensor: Connector Views Engine Controls Connector End Views Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor Page 7480 - A control module from another vehicle is installed. - Revised software/calibration files have been released for this vehicle. - IMPORTANT: DO NOT re-program the control module with the SAME software/calibration files that are already present in the control module. This is not an effective repair for any type of concern. Verify that the control module contains the correct software/calibration. If incorrect programming is found, reprogram the control module with the most current software/calibration. Refer to Control Module References for replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Testing for Short to Ground TESTING FOR SHORT TO GROUND NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 4. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit. With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is a short to ground in the circuit. Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2. Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). - When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. - If the DMM does not display voltage 4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is shorted. Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A DIGITAL MULTIMETER NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the powertrain control module (PCM), should only be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200 Digital Multimeter (DMM). The J 39200 instruction manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminage even though voltage is present. The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity. IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading. Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the measurement. Page 3315 Open the harness by removing any tape. 2. Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. 3. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 4. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent american wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 5. Slide a section of high temperature SCT1 shrink tubing down the length of wire to be spliced. Ensure that the shrink tubing will not interfere with the splice procedure. 6. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 7. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. 8. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 9. Insert the wire into the DuraSeal splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 10. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Page 5612 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches, and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original. - The wires insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the possibility of fuel contact. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1). 5. Select the proper duraseal splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool. Refer to the Crimp and Seal Splice Table. 6. Place the duraseal splice sleeve in the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115) crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 7. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to hold the duraseal splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 8. Insert the wires into the duraseal splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel in order to prevent the wire from passing through the splice (3). 9. Close the handles of the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115), until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is applied to the splice sleeve. 10. Shrink the insulation around the splice. - Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. - Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Splicing Inline Harness Diodes SPLICING INLINE HARNESS DIODES Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure. 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode. 2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool. 5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode. Page 7065 3. Disconnect the connector from the component. 4. Remove the dress cover by using a flat bladed tool to release the dress cover locking tabs and lift up on the dress cover. 5. Cut the tie wrap that holds the wires to the connector body. Page 7667 7. Pressing the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool in the release cavity of the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and crimper in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (DOOR MODULE) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Side view of connector. View of top of connector. 1. Locate the assist lever and lock on the top of the connector. Page 7022 3. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. View showing depressing of the lever lock release tab. Page 9069 7. Pressing the J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) tool in the release cavity of the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and crimper in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (Door Module) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (DOOR MODULE) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Side view of connector. View of top of connector. 1. Locate the assist lever and lock on the top of the connector. Power Seat Switch Replacement Power Seat Switch: Service and Repair Power Seat Switch Replacement POWER SEAT SWITCH REPLACEMENT REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Remove the switch bezel assembly from the seat assembly. 2. Remove the buttons from the switch. 3. Release the tabs that retain the seat switch to the seat bezel assembly. 4. Disconnect the electrical connector from the switch. 5. Remove the seat switch from the seat bezel assembly. INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 1. Connect the electrical connector to the switch. 2. Install the seat switch to the seat bezel assembly. Verify that the retaining tabs are fully seated. 3. Install the buttons on the switch. 4. Install the switch bezel assembly to the seat assembly. Page 4934 2. Locate the two indents of the terminal position assurance (TPA) located on the bottom of the connector body. Page 6440 View of the connector when released from the component. View of another type of Micro 64 connector. Page 6977 7. Connect the MAF/IAT electrical connector. Page 1755 6. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry one side of the nose piece up to the pre-stage position. When the nose piece is in the pre-staged position, the nose piece will be raised above the connector body the length of the step in the nose piece. 7. Use a small flat-blade tool to pry the other side of the piece to the pre-stage position. If the nose piece is higher than the first step in the nose piece, gently push down on the nose piece until it meets with resistance from the connector body, you should feel the nose piece click into position. Page 292 Pedal Positioning Relay: Locations Underhood Fuse Block Fuse Block - Underhood (5.3L/6.0L), Label Page 6437 - Most Molex connectors will have the Molex logo on the dresscover of the connector. In some cases the connectors may have MX followed by another letter. The third letter indicates where the connector was made. A connector with MXD is a Molex connector made in Detroit. Sumitomo has a unique symbol on their connector and possibly a part number. The symbol is similar to that of a diamond lying on its side, similar to that shown. The logo could appear anywhere but the most common place is at the wire side of the housing. Tyco/AMP has many different and unique connector designs. Some may or may not have identifiable marks on them. Page 2611 MOLEX CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. 2. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. Page 2351 The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors. 1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position. 4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool J 38125-10A (GM P/N 12014012-1) into the front (mating end) of the connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal through the back of the connector (2). IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector. 6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. 7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily. 10. Perform system check. Delphi Connectors (12 Way) DELPHI CONNECTORS (12-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. Page 5327 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) and slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. Page 4674 6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias. Reference the appropriate service manual wiring schematic to obtain the correct diode installation position. 7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for the soldering equipment. 8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed. 9. IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode attachment points with tape. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape. Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable SPLICING TWISTED OR SHIELDED CABLE Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable. 1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splice is made. 3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire. Staggering the splices by 65 mm (2.5 in) is recommended. 4. IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical contact with the drain wire. Re-assemble the cable. Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape. - Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1). - Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire. - Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape. Page 2441 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the connector. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. 4. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front of the connector. Page 6262 View of the female half of the connector with male terminals. View of the male half of the connector with female terminals. 4. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers CIRCUIT PROTECTION - CIRCUIT BREAKERS A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types of circuit Page 2352 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) and slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. Engine/Transmission - Aftermarket Calibrations Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine/Transmission - Aftermarket Calibrations INFORMATION Bulletin No.: 09-06-04-026B Date: April 07, 2010 Subject: Identifying Non-GM (Aftermarket) Engine and Transmission Calibrations for V8 Gas Engines Using Tech 2(R) or Global Diagnostic System (GDS) Models: 2006-2010 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Excluding Saab 9-7X) 2006-2009 HUMMER H2 2006-2010 HUMMER H3 Equipped with V8 Gas Powered Engines Only Attention: This bulletin applies to V8 gas powered engines ONLY. For Duramax(TM) diesel powered engines, refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 08-06-04-006G. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2010 model year and information about retrieving calibrations on a Global A vehicle. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 09-06-04-026A (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). General Motors is identifying an increasing number of engine, transmission and catalytic converter part failures that are the result of non-GM (aftermarket) engine and transmission control calibrations being used. When alteration to the GM-released engine or transmission control calibrations occurs, it subjects powertrain and driveline components (engine, transmission, transfer case, driveshaft and rear axle) to stresses that were not tested by General Motors. It is because of these unknown stresses, and the potential to alter reliability, durability and emissions performance, that GM has adopted a policy that prevents any UNAUTHORIZED dealer warranty claim submissions to any remaining warranty coverage, to the powertrain and driveline components whenever the presence of a non-GM (aftermarket) calibration is confirmed - even if the non-GM control module calibration is subsequently removed. Warranty coverage is based on the equipment and calibrations that were released on the vehicle at time of sale, or subsequently updated by GM. That's because GM testing and validation matches the calibration to a host of criteria that is essential to assure reliability, durability and emissions performance over the life of the warranty coverage and beyond. Stresses resulting from calibrations different from those tested and released by GM can damage or weaken components, leading to poor performance and or shortened life. Additionally, non-GM (aftermarket) issued engine control modifications often do not meet the same emissions performance standards as GM issued calibrations. Depending on state statutes, individuals who install engine control module calibrations that put the vehicle outside the parameters of emissions certification standards may be subject to fines and/or penalties. This bulletin outlines a procedure to identify the presence of non-GM (aftermarket) calibrations. GM recommends performing this check whenever a hard part failure is seen on internal engine or transmission components, or before an engine assembly or transmission assembly is being replaced under warranty. It is also recommended that the engine calibration verification procedure be performed whenever diagnostics indicate that catalytic converter replacement is indicated. The PQC has a process to confirm the ECM/PCM calibration is GM issued. The PQC will require a picture of the engine calibration verification screen, as outlined in this bulletin, before authorizing any V8 gas powered engine replacement. If a non-GM calibration is found and verification has taken place through GM, the remaining powertrain and driveline warranty will be blocked and notated in GMVIS and the dealership will be notified. This block prevents any UNAUTHORIZED warranty claim submission. 1. Connect the Tech 2(R) to the vehicle. 2. Go to: Diagnostics and build the vehicle. 3. Select: Powertrain. 4. Select: Engine. 5. *Select: Engine Control Module or PCM. 6. *Select: Module ID Information or I/M Information System if the Module ID Information selection is not available. 7. *If "I/M information System" was selected, it may be necessary to select "Vehicle Information" in order to display the calibration information. ‹› If the CVN information is displayed as "N/A", it will be necessary to contact the TCSC to obtain the CVN information. Page 3635 hot particles embed themselves in the chrome layer and create a small pit. If the material is allowed to sit on the wheel while it is exposed to moisture or salt, it will corrode the wheel beneath the chrome leaving a pit or small blister in the chrome. Heavy brake dust build-up should be removed from wheels by using GM Chrome Cleaner and Polish, P/N 1050173 (in Canada use 10953013). For moderate cleaning, light brake dust build-up or water spots use GM Swirl Remover Polish, P/N 12377965 (in Canada, use Meguiars Plast-X(TM) Clear Plastic Cleaner and Polish #G12310C**). After cleaning, the wheel should be waxed using GM Cleaner Wax, P/N 12377966 (in Canada, use Meguiars Cleaner Wax #M0616C**), which will help protect the wheel from brake dust and reduce adhesion of any brake dust that gets on the wheel surface. For general maintenance cleaning, PEEK Metal Polish† may be used. It will clean and shine the chrome and leave behind a wax coating that may help protect the finish. Warranty of Stardust Corroded Chrome Wheels Wheels returned with pitting or spotting as a result of neglect and brake dust build-up may be replaced one time. Important Notify the customer that this is a one time replacement. Please stress to the customer the vital importance of keeping the wheels clean and free of prolonged exposure to brake dust build-up. "GM of Canada" dealers require prior approval by the District Manager - Customer Care and Service Process (DM-CCSP). Customer Assistance and Instructions GM has looked for ways customers may improve the appearance of wheels damaged by acidic cleaners. The following product and procedure has been found to dramatically improve the appearance of stained wheels. For wheels that have milky stains caused by acidic cleaners try the following: Notice THE 3M CHROME AND METAL POLISH REQUIRED FOR THIS PROCEDURE IS AN EXTREMELY AGGRESSIVE POLISH/CLEANER. THE WHEELS MUST BE CLEANED BEFORE APPLICATION TO AVOID SCRATCHING THE WHEEL SURFACE. THIS PRODUCT WILL REDUCE THE THICKNESS OF THE CHROME PLATING ON THE WHEEL AND IF USED INCORRECTLY OR EXCESSIVELY MAY REMOVE THE CHROME PLATING ALL TOGETHER, EXPOSING A LESS BRIGHT AND BRASSY COLORED SUB-LAYER. FOLLOW INSTRUCTIONS EXACTLY. 1. Wash the wheels with vigorously with soap and water. This step will clean and may reduce wheel staining. Flood all areas of the wheel with water to rinse. 2. Dry the wheels completely. Notice Begin with a small section of the wheel and with light pressure buff off polish and examine results. ONLY apply and rub with sufficient force and time to remove enough staining that you are satisfied with the results. Some wheels may be stained to the extent that you may only achieve a 50% improvement while others may be able to be restored to the original lustre. IN ALL CASES, only apply until the results are satisfactory. 3. Apply 3M Chrome and Metal Polish #39527* with a clean terry cloth towel. As you apply the polish, the staining will be diminished. 4. When dry, buff off the polish with a clean portion of the towel. 5. Repeat application of the 3M Chrome and Metal Polish until satisfied with the results. If continued applications fail to improve the appearance further discontinue use. This procedure will improve the appearance of the wheels and may, with repeated applications, restore the finish dramatically. For wheels that exhibit spotting from road chemicals the above procedure may marginally improve the condition but will not restore the finish or remove the pitting. In this type of staining the wheel finish has actually been removed in spots and no manner of cleaning will restore the finish. †*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may be available from other sources. Parts Information Page 7496 - In some cases Delphi will actually be printed on the connector. If Delphi is not printed on the connector, look for PED. In both cases there is no specific orientation for Delphi or PED and they can appear anywhere on the connector. - FCI connectors may have the FCI logo on their connectors. The logo is the letters FCI with an "A" above it. - JAE connector have JAE in small letters on their connectors. Page 5844 4. Use a small flat-blade tool to slide the terminal position assurance (TPA) up one notch on both ends of the connector. The TPA is located underneath the wire dress cover. For the larger terminals insert the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. For the smaller terminals insert the J 38125-560 (GM P/N 15314260) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 7511 The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors. 1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position. 4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool J 38125-10A (GM P/N 12014012-1) into the front (mating end) of the connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal through the back of the connector (2). IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector. 6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. 7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily. 10. Perform system check. Delphi Connectors (12 Way) DELPHI CONNECTORS (12-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. Page 8944 MOLEX CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. 2. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. Page 1473 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully raise the TPA on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA cannot be removed from the connector while there are terminals present in the connector body. View of the TPA when removed from the connector body. 4. Use the J 38125-12A tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the left side of the terminal release cavity as shown in the graphic. Use the tool to move the terminal release to the right with a gentle prying motion. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 8559 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to very carefully raise the TPA on both sides of the connector. IMPORTANT: The TPA cannot be removed from the connector while there are terminals present in the connector body. View of the TPA when removed from the connector body. 4. Use the J 38125-12A tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the left side of the terminal release cavity as shown in the graphic. Use the tool to move the terminal release to the right with a gentle prying motion. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. Page 1520 Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Camshaft Position Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure 1. Remove the generator bracket assembly. 2. Remove the camshaft position sensor mounting bolts (1). 3. Remove the camshaft position sensor assembly (4, 5, 6) from the front cover (7). 4. Disconnect the camshaft position sensor jumper harness (2) and the engine harness (3) electrical connectors. 5. Remove the camshaft sensor assembly (4, 5, 6). 6. Disconnect camshaft position sensor (5) from the jumper harness (4). Installation Procedure 1. Reconnect the camshaft sensor (5) and the jumper harness (4). 2. Install the O-ring (6) on the camshaft sensor assembly (4, 5). 3. Reconnect the camshaft position sensor assembly (4, 5, 6) and the engine harness connector (3). Page 5316 View of the connector when released from the component. View of another type of Micro 64 connector. Page 8424 5. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Kostal Connectors KOSTAL CONNECTORS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Page 6518 Page 6575 4. Slide the dress cover forward and off of the connector. 5. The terminal positive assurance (TPA) is located in the front and rear of the connector. Page 7160 Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. For connectors with a bolt in the dress cover, turn the bolt counterclockwise to remove the connector from the component. 2. Locate the connector position assurance (CPA) on the top of the wire dress cover. Slide the CPA forward. Page 3429 If a wire is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm, etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except coaxial. - Do not use the DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent American wire gage (AWG) size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 in order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 6065 vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide variety of actions, including: - Wiggling the harness - Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting - Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector - Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation - Relocating a harness or wires All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. Another option is, with the component commanded ON and OFF by the scan tool, move related connectors and wiring and observe the component operation. With the engine running, move related connectors and wiring while monitoring engine operation. If harness or connector movement affects the data displayed, component/system operation, or engine operation, inspect and repair the harness/connections as necessary. You may need to load the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these cases you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide good results as well. There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions, along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the circuit to these kinds of conditions. SALT WATER SPRAY Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture. Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5 percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously. HIGH TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070. Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault condition. The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis. This option does not allow for the same control, however. LOW TEMPERATURE CONDITIONS Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect. If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to -18°C (0°F) from one end and +71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized cooling needs. Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or components in an effort to duplicate the concern. DUPLICATING FAILURE CONDITIONS - If none of the previous tests are successful, attempt to duplicate and/or capture the failure conditions. Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, where applicable, contains the conditions that were present when the DTC set. 1. Review and record Freeze Frame/Failure Records data. 2. Clear the DTCs using the scan tool. 3. Turn the key to OFF and wait 15 seconds. 4. Operate the vehicle under the same conditions that were noted in Freeze Frame/Failure Records data, as closely as possible. The vehicle must also be operating within the Conditions for Running the DTC. Refer to Conditions for Running the DTC in the supporting text if a DTC is being diagnosed. 5. Monitor DTC Status for the DTC being tested. The scan tool will indicate Ran, when the enabling conditions have been satisfied long enough for the DTC to run. The scan tool will also indicate whether the DTC passed or failed. - An alternate method is to drive the vehicle with the DMM connected to a suspected circuit. An abnormal reading on the DMM when the concern occurs, may help you locate the concern. Measuring Frequency Page 8671 5. Insert the J 38125-557 (GM P/N 12122378) into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 6. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Connector Position Assurance Locks CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of the connector. CPAs are used in various connectors throughout the vehicle. CPAs are also used in all SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals, of the connector. Connector Repairs CONNECTOR REPAIRS Page 8156 2. Locate the nose piece locking tabs that are positioned on the side of the connector nose piece. The connector nose piece acts as a terminal positive assurance (TPA) and may be referred to as such. 3. Use a small flat-blade tool to push in one of the locking tabs while gently pulling on the same side of the nose piece. 4. Repeat the procedure for the other locking tab and remove the nose piece. 5. Remove the wire dress cover. The following is a general procedure for wire dress cover removal. Use this procedure as a guide, some dress cover removal procedures may vary. 6. Use fingers to squeeze the 2 locking legs of the cover. Tires/Wheels - Low Tire/Leaking Cast Aluminum Wheels Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Tires/Wheels - Low Tire/Leaking Cast Aluminum Wheels TECHNICAL Bulletin No.: 05-03-10-003F Date: April 27, 2010 Subject: Low Tire Pressure, Leaking Cast Aluminum Wheels (Repair with Adhesive Sealant) Models: 2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X with Cast Aluminum Wheels Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the model years and the bulletin reference information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 05-03-10-003E (Section 03 - Suspension). Condition Some customers may comment on a low tire pressure condition. Diagnosis of the low tire pressure condition indicates an air leak through the cast aluminum wheel. Cause Porosity in the cast aluminum wheel may be the cause. Notice This bulletin specifically addresses issues related to the wheel casting that may result in an air leak. For issues related to corrosion of the wheel in service, please refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 08-03-10-006C - Tire Slowly Goes Flat, Tire Air Loss, Low Tire Pressure Warning Light Illuminated, Aluminum Wheel Bead Seat Corrosion (Clean and Resurface Wheel Bead Seat). Correction 1. Remove the tire and wheel assembly from the vehicle. Refer to the appropriate service procedure in SI. 2. Locate the leaking area by inflating the tire to 276 kPa (40 psi) and dipping the tire/wheel assembly in a water bath, or use a spray bottle with soap and water to locate the specific leak location. Important - If the porosity leak is located in the bead area of the aluminum rim (where the tire meets the rim), the wheel should be replaced. - If two or more leaks are located on one wheel, the wheel should be replaced. 3. If air bubbles are observed, mark the location. - If the leak location is on the tire/rubber area, refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 04-03-10-001F Tire Puncture Repair Procedures for All Cars and Light Duty Trucks. - If the leak is located on the aluminum wheel area, continue with the next step. 4. Inscribe a mark on the tire at the valve stem in order to indicate the orientation of the tire to the wheel. 5. Dismount the tire from the wheel. Refer to Tire Mounting and Dismounting. 6. Remove the tire pressure sensor. Refer to Tire Pressure Sensor removal procedure in SI. 7. Scuff the INSIDE rim surface at the leak area with #80 grit paper and clean the area with general purpose cleaner, such as 3M(R) General Purpose Adhesive Cleaner, P/N 08984, or equivalent. 8. Apply a 3 mm (0.12 in) thick layer of Silicone - Adhesive/Sealant, P/N 12378478 (in Canada, use 88900041), or equivalent, to the leak area. 9. Allow for the adhesive/sealant to dry. Notice Caution must be used when mounting the tire so as not to damage the sealer. Damaging the repair area may result in an air leak. Page 8482 4. Install the fuel feed (1) and EVAP (2) lines to the sender assembly. 5. Install the fuel tank. Page 7576 Page 3099 Coolant: Fluid Type Specifications ENGINE COOLANT The cooling system in your vehicle is filled with DEX-COOL engine coolant. This coolant is designed to remain in your vehicle for 5 years or 150,000 miles (240 000 km), whichever occurs first, if you add only DEX-COOL extended life coolant. A 50/50 mixture of clean, drinkable water and DEX-COOL coolant will: - Give freezing protection down to -34°F (-37°C). - Give boiling protection up to 265°F (129°C). - Protect against rust and corrosion. - Help keep the proper engine temperature. - Let the warning lights and gages work as they should. NOTICE: Using coolant other than DEX-COOL may cause premature engine, heater core or radiator corrosion. In addition, the engine coolant may require changing sooner, at 30,000 miles (50 000 km) or 24 months, whichever occurs first. Any repairs would not be covered by your warranty. Always use DEX-COOL (silicate-free) coolant in your vehicle. WHAT TO USE Use a mixture of one-half clean, drinkable water and one-half DEX-COOL coolant which won't damage aluminum parts. If you use this coolant mixture, you don't need to add anything else. CAUTION: Adding only plain water to your cooling system can be dangerous. Plain water, or some other liquid such as alcohol, can boil before the proper coolant mixture will. Your vehicle's coolant warning system is set for the proper coolant mixture. With plain water or the wrong mixture, your engine could get too hot but you would not get the overheat warning. Your engine could catch fire and you or others could be burned. Use a 50/50 mixture of clean, drinkable water and DEX-COOL coolant. NOTICE: If you use an improper coolant mixture, your engine could overheat and be badly damaged. The repair cost would not be covered by your warranty. Too much water in the mixture can freeze and crack the engine, radiator, heater core and other parts. If you have to add coolant more than four times a year, check your cooling system. NOTICE: If you use the proper coolant, you do not have to add extra inhibitors or additives which claim to improve the system. These can be harmful. Page 2554 All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system. Page 3712 All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system. Page 5366 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Start in the middle and gradually move the heat barrel to the open ends of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Heated Oxygen Sensor Wiring Repairs HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being obstructed. If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. - Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks, etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire. - Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance. - To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector. Page 1513 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire. 2. Cut the wire. - Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. - Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches, and connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage. 3. Select the proper size and type of wire. - The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original. - The wires insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures. - Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected. IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked polyethylene with PVC. Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the possibility of fuel contact. 4. Strip the insulation. - Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1). 5. Select the proper duraseal splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool. Refer to the Crimp and Seal Splice Table. 6. Place the duraseal splice sleeve in the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115) crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 7. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to hold the duraseal splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 8. Insert the wires into the duraseal splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel in order to prevent the wire from passing through the splice (3). 9. Close the handles of the J-38125-8 (GM P/N 12085115), until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is applied to the splice sleeve. 10. Shrink the insulation around the splice. - Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. - Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Splicing Inline Harness Diodes SPLICING INLINE HARNESS DIODES Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure. 1. Open the harness. - If the harness is taped, remove the tape. - To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness. - If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode. 2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool. 5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode. Page 1248 Headlamp Switch: Diagrams Headlamp Switch C1 Page 8255 6. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs located on the opposite side of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover at the connector end and pry up. 7. Remove the dress cover. 8. Cut the tie wrap on the wire bundle. 9. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting a small flat-bladed tool into the small slot in the end of the slider and pushing on the TPA until it comes out of the connector. When the TPA exits the opposite side of the connector, gasp the TPA and pull it completely out of the connector. 10. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. Page 6968 Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Connector Views Engine Controls Connector End Views Mass Air Flow (MAF)/Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor Page 5967 View of the connector when released from the component. View of another type of Micro 64 connector. Page 353 Radiator Cooling Fan Control Module: Diagnostic Aids Arrows and Symbols Arrows and Symbols This Service Data uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations. Arrows and Symbols 1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow Basic Knowledge Required GENERAL ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures contained in the service manual. You should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current (amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram, as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. Decimal and Metric Equivalents Decimal and Metric Equivalents Page 8357 Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Service and Repair Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor Replacement Removal Procedure Notice: Use care when handling the coolant sensor. Damage to the coolant sensor will affect the operation of the fuel control system. 1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Raise and suitably support the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 3. Drain the cooling system below the level of the ECT sensor. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System (LL8) Draining and Filling Cooling System (LH6, LS2). 4. Lower the vehicle. 5. Disconnect the engine coolant temperature (ECT) sensor electrical connector (1). 6. Remove the ECT sensor. Installation Procedure Notice: Replacement components must be the correct part number for the application. Components requiring the use of the thread locking compound, lubricants, corrosion inhibitors, or sealants are identified in the service procedure. Some replacement components may come with these coatings already applied. Do not use these coatings on components unless specified. These coatings can affect the final torque, which may affect the operation of the component. Use the correct torque specification when installing components in order to avoid damage. Notice: Use care when handling the coolant sensor. Damage to the coolant sensor will affect the operation of the fuel control system. 1. Coat the ECT sensor threads with sealer GM P/N 12346004 (Canadian P/N 10953480), or equivalent. Page 5304 5. Use a small flat-blade tool to remove TPA from the connector. 6. Use the J 38125-213 or the J 38125-556 (GM P/N 12093647) tool to release the terminals by inserting the tool into the terminal release cavity. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Page 6367 3. Ensure that the terminal release tang access panel is in the correct location to access the terminals. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) into the terminal release tang access slot located behind the access panel of the connector and press down on the terminal while carefully pulling the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Tyco/AMP Connectors (0.25 Cap) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (025 CAP) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component by pressing down on the connector position assurance (CPA). Page 4542 3. Ensure that the terminal release tang access panel is in the correct location to access the terminals. 4. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position. 5. Insert the J 38125-11A (GM P/N 12094430) into the terminal release tang access slot located behind the access panel of the connector and press down on the terminal while carefully pulling the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Tyco/AMP Connectors (0.25 Cap) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (025 CAP) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit TERMINAL REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Disconnect the connector from the component by pressing down on the connector position assurance (CPA). Page 2280 6. Place the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper handles slightly in order to firmly hold the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper nest. 7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. 9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel. 10. Start in the middle and gradually move the heat barrel to the open ends of the tubing: - The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation. - A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is achieved. Heated Oxygen Sensor Wiring Repairs HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR WIRING REPAIRS TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being obstructed. If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance. The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor: Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors. These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems. - Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks, etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire. - Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance. - To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the vehicle harness connector. Page 5608 If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.). Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves and splice crimping tool from the J-38125. Use the following wiring repair procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the DuraSeal splice sleeves. 1. IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact. Open the harness by removing any tape: - Use a sewing seam ripper, available from sewing supply stores, in order to cut open the harness in order to avoid wire insulation damage. - Use the DuraSeal splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. - Do not use the crimp and DuraSeal splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming together. 2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to change the location of a splice.Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices, harness branches, or connectors. 3. Strip the insulation: - When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire. - Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size. - Use an AWG wire gage. - If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation. - Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. - Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. - If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section. 4. Select the proper DuraSeal splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the above table at the beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of the DuraSeal splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests. 5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J-38125 to crimp DuraSeal splice sleeve. In order to position the DuraSeal splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool. The crimp tool has three nests, 1 is for the salmon and green splice sleeve, 2 is for the blue splice sleeve, and 3 is for the yellow splice sleeve. Page 6404 Page 2288 11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the solder equipment. 12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. 13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to cover the first piece of tape. Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves SPLICING COPPER WIRE USING SPLICE SLEEVES TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit IMPORTANT: Use only dura seal splice sleeves. Other splice sleeves may not protect the splice from moisture or provide a good electrical connection. Use duraseal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial. Use duraseal splice sleeves where there is special requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire using duraseal splice sleeves. Page 1880 Release the lower wiredress cover locking tab. Release the upper wiredress cover locking tab. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. Page 4915 View of a typical Micro 64 connector. Depress the lock and pull the lever over and past the lock. Page 501 7. Apply pressure and gently rock the cover until one locking leg is unseated. 8. Continue to apply pressure and rock the cover until the second locking leg is unseated. Repeat procedure for the other side of the dress cover and remove the cover. 9. Use J 38125-12A (GM P/N 12094429) to gently lift the terminal retaining tab while gently pulling the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 10. If the terminal is severely bent or damaged, it may be possible on some connectors to push the wire out of the front of the connector instead of Page 2844 Alignment: Specifications Trim Height Specifications Trim Height Specifications Trim Height Specifications Page 6009 View of the release tool being used for the larger terminals. View of the release tool being used for the smaller terminals. 7. While holding the removal tool in place, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Location of the terminal in the repair tray and the proper crimp tool can be found in the appropriate connector end view. Yazaki Connectors (2-Way) YAZAKI CONNECTORS (2-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit Page 5250 Engine Control Module (ECM) C2 (Pin 55 To 73) Engine Control Module (ECM) C3 Locations Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Locations Park Neutral Position (PNP) Switch 1 - Automatic Transmission 4L60-E/4L65-E/4L70 2 - Park/Neutral Position (PNP) Switch Page 7793 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Remove the TPA by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the TPA. Gently pry the TPA out of the connector. 6. Remove the nose piece by inserting a small flat-blade tool into the locking tabs on both sides of the nose piece. Gently pry the nose piece out of the connector. Page 5323 pulling it through. This will prevent damage to the internal seals of the connector. Once the terminal is pushed out of the connector, cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible and pull the wire through the connector. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE The Micro-Pack 100W connectors have small terminals that are difficult to handle and hold when crimping. In order to aid the technician when crimping these terminals, a new crimping tool was developed. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool was developed to crimp Micro-Pack 100W terminals. The J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool has a terminal holding block that will hold the terminal in place while the terminal is being crimped. After the terminal is removed from the connector perform the following procedure in order to repair Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 2. IMPORTANT: After cutting the damaged terminal from the wire, determine if the remaining wire is long enough to reach the connector without putting a strain on the wire. If the wire is not long enough, splice a small length of the same gage wire to the existing wire, then crimp the new terminal on the added wire. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 3. Depress the spring loaded locator of the J 38125-101 (W jaw) crimping tool until the terminal holder is completely visible. 4. Insert the terminal into the crimp tool until the core wings are flush with the anvil on the crimp tool. Be sure that the wings are pointed toward the crimp tool former and release the spring locator. The locator will hold the terminal in place. Inspect the alignment of the terminal wings with the crimp tool former. If the terminal wings are wider than the crimp tool former, remove the terminal and bend the terminal wings in slightly. 5. Place stripped wire into terminal. 6. Crimp the new terminal to the wire. If a jam occurs, press the emergency release to open applicator. TERMINAL REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE After the terminal is crimped to the wire perform the following procedure in order to replace Micro-Pack 100 terminals. 1. Slide the new terminal into the correct cavity at the back of the connector. Page 7541 5. While pushing the terminal forward, insert the J 38125-24 in the release cavity above the terminal you are removing, gently pull the wire out of the back of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125 in order to replace the terminal. Tyco/AMP Connectors (43-Way) TYCO/AMP CONNECTORS (43-WAY) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125 Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Locate the lever lock on the wire dress cover. Slide the lever lock away from the connector body. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs on the dress cover of the connector. Using a small flat-blade tool release all of the locking tabs. 4. Once the locks are unlocked, lift the dress cover off. 5. IMPORTANT: Always use care when removing a terminal position assurance (TPA) in order to avoid damaging it. Page 6426 difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Bosch Connectors (ECM) BOSCH CONNECTORS (ECM) TOOLS REQUIRED J-38125Terminal Repair Kit REMOVAL PROCEDURE 1. Locate the assist lever on the top of the connector. Move the assist lever to the forward position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. Page 4821 REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. The release tab is located on the top of the wiredress cover. View of connector in released position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Page 6678 5. Insert the J 38125-557 (GM P/N 12122378) into the 2 cavities on each side of the terminal at the front of the connector and push until you feel the tool disengage the terminal retainers. See the release tool cross reference in the Reference Guide of the J-38125 to ensure that the correct release tool is used. 6. Carefully pull the terminal out of the connector. Always remember never use force when pulling a terminal out of a connector. If the terminal is difficult to remove, repeat the entire procedure. TERMINAL REPAIR PROCEDURE Use the appropriate terminal and follow the instructions in the J-38125. Connector Position Assurance Locks CONNECTOR POSITION ASSURANCE LOCKS The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of the connector. CPAs are used in various connectors throughout the vehicle. CPAs are also used in all SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to ensure good contact between the mating terminals, of the connector. Connector Repairs CONNECTOR REPAIRS Page 2814 Windshield Washer Fluid Level Switch (With RPO Code U68) Page 6568 REMOVAL PROCEDURE Follow the steps below in order to remove terminals from the connector. 1. Slide the lever lock forward while pressing down on the lever lock release tab. The release tab is located on the top of the wiredress cover. View of connector in released position. 2. Disconnect the connector from the component. 3. Locate the dress cover locking tabs at the corners of the dress cover. Use a small flat-blade tool to release the locking tabs and remove the dress cover. Page 5159 - A control module from another vehicle is installed. - Revised software/calibration files have been released for this vehicle. - IMPORTANT: DO NOT re-program the control module with the SAME software/calibration files that are already present in the control module. This is not an effective repair for any type of concern. Verify that the control module contains the correct software/calibration. If incorrect programming is found, reprogram the control module with the most current software/calibration. Refer to Control Module References for replacement, setup, and programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning Testing for Short to Ground TESTING FOR SHORT TO GROUND NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit. With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the ohm position. 4. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit. With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the load. 3. Connect one lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the other lead of the test lamp to one end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is a short to ground in the circuit. Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2. Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). - When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. - If the DMM does not display voltage 4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is shorted. Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter TROUBLESHOOTING WITH A DIGITAL MULTIMETER NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice. IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the powertrain control module (PCM), should only be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200 Digital Multimeter (DMM). The J 39200 instruction manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference. A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits. While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present if the impedance is low enough, a DMM indicates how much voltage is present. In other words, if there is not enough current, the test lamp will not illuminage even though voltage is present. The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity. IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading. Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the measurement. Page 7770 6. Locate the 2 dress cover locking tabs located on the opposite side of the connector. Insert a small flat-bladed tool between the cover at the connector end and pry up. 7. Remove the dress cover. 8. Cut the tie wrap on the wire bundle. 9. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) by inserting a small flat-bladed tool into the small slot in the end of the slider and pushing on the TPA until it comes out of the connector. When the TPA exits the opposite side of the connector, gasp the TPA and pull it completely out of the connector. 10. Push the wire side of the terminal that is being removed toward the connector and hold it in position.